diff --git a/3rdparty/imnodes/.clang-format b/3rdparty/imnodes/.clang-format new file mode 100644 index 0000000..eec9c23 --- /dev/null +++ b/3rdparty/imnodes/.clang-format @@ -0,0 +1,39 @@ +--- +AccessModifierOffset: -4 +AlignAfterOpenBracket: 'AlwaysBreak' +AlignConsecutiveDeclarations: 'true' +AllowAllParametersOfDeclarationOnNextLine: 'false' +AllowShortFunctionsOnASingleLine: 'true' +AlwaysBreakBeforeMultilineStrings: 'true' +AlwaysBreakTemplateDeclarations: 'true' +BinPackArguments: 'false' +BinPackParameters: 'false' +BraceWrapping: { + AfterCaseLabel: 'true' + AfterClass: 'true' + AfterControlStatement: 'true' + AfterEnum: 'true' + AfterFunction: 'true' + AfterNamespace: 'true' + AfterStruct: 'true' + AfterUnion: 'true' + BeforeCatch: 'true' + BeforeElse: 'true' + IndentBraces: 'false' +} +BreakBeforeBraces: Custom +ColumnLimit: 100 +Cpp11BracedListStyle: 'true' +DerivePointerAlignment: 'false' +IndentCaseLabels: 'false' +IndentWidth: 4 +PenaltyExcessCharacter: 100000000 +PenaltyReturnTypeOnItsOwnLine: 100000000 +PointerAlignment: Left +PointerBindsToType: 'true' +SortIncludes: 'false' +SpaceAfterTemplateKeyword: 'false' +SpaceBeforeParens: ControlStatements +TabWidth: 8 +UseTab: Never +... diff --git a/3rdparty/imnodes/.clang-tidy b/3rdparty/imnodes/.clang-tidy new file mode 100644 index 0000000..1762ff7 --- /dev/null +++ b/3rdparty/imnodes/.clang-tidy @@ -0,0 +1,33 @@ +# Apply this style by doing +# +# clang-tidy -fix-errors -config= +# +# Running the command without -fix-errors will generate warnings about each +# style violation but won't change them. + +Checks: '-*,readability-identifier-naming' +CheckOptions: + - key: readability-identifier-naming.ClassCase + value: CamelCase + - key: readability-identifier-naming.EnumCase + value: CamelCase + - key: readability-identifier-naming.FunctionCase + value: CamelCase + - key: readability-identifier-naming.MemberCase + value: CamelCase + - key: readability-identifier-naming.MethodCase + value: CamelCase + - key: readability-identifier-naming.NamespaceCase + value: CamelCase + - key: readability-identifier-naming.ParameterCase + value: lower_case + - key: readability-identifier-naming.PrivateMemberCase + value: CamelCase + - key: readability-identifier-naming.PrivateMemberPrefix + value: '_' + - key: readability-identifier-naming.StaticConstantCase + value: UPPER_CASE + - key: readability-identifier-naming.StructCase + value: CamelCase + - key: readability-identifier-naming.VariableCase + value: lower_case diff --git a/3rdparty/imnodes/.github/workflows/build.yaml b/3rdparty/imnodes/.github/workflows/build.yaml new file mode 100644 index 0000000..de140e8 --- /dev/null +++ b/3rdparty/imnodes/.github/workflows/build.yaml @@ -0,0 +1,19 @@ +name: Build +on: [push, pull_request] + +jobs: + build: + runs-on: ubuntu-latest + container: + image: docker://nelarius/imnodes-docker-builder:latest + steps: + # This step uses checkout action: https://github.com/actions/checkout + - name: Checkout + uses: actions/checkout@v2 + id: checkout + - name: premake5 + run: premake5 gmake --sdl-include-path=/usr/include/SDL2 + - name: make-debug + run: make all config=debug -j + - name: make-release + run: make all config=release -j diff --git a/3rdparty/imnodes/.gitignore b/3rdparty/imnodes/.gitignore new file mode 100644 index 0000000..3c07540 --- /dev/null +++ b/3rdparty/imnodes/.gitignore @@ -0,0 +1,502 @@ +### Project ### + +TODO.md + +### ImGui ### +**.ini + +### Local build ### +bin/ +build/ +lib/ +imnodes.sln + +# Created by https://www.toptal.com/developers/gitignore/api/sublimetext +# Edit at https://www.toptal.com/developers/gitignore?templates=sublimetext + +### SublimeText ### +# Cache files for Sublime Text +*.tmlanguage.cache +*.tmPreferences.cache +*.stTheme.cache + +# Workspace files are user-specific +*.sublime-workspace + +# Project files should be checked into the repository, unless a significant +# proportion of contributors will probably not be using Sublime Text +*.sublime-project + +# SFTP configuration file +sftp-config.json +sftp-config-alt*.json + +# Package control specific files +Package Control.last-run +Package Control.ca-list +Package Control.ca-bundle +Package Control.system-ca-bundle +Package Control.cache/ +Package Control.ca-certs/ +Package Control.merged-ca-bundle +Package Control.user-ca-bundle +oscrypto-ca-bundle.crt +bh_unicode_properties.cache + +# Sublime-github package stores a github token in this file +# https://packagecontrol.io/packages/sublime-github +GitHub.sublime-settings + +# End of https://www.toptal.com/developers/gitignore/api/sublimetext + +# Created by https://www.gitignore.io/api/c,c++ + +### C ### +# Prerequisites +*.d + +# Object files +*.o +*.ko +*.obj +*.elf + +# Linker output +*.ilk +*.map +*.exp + +# Precompiled Headers +*.gch +*.pch + +# Libraries +*.lib +*.a +*.la +*.lo + +# Shared objects (inc. Windows DLLs) +*.dll +*.so +*.so.* +*.dylib + +# Executables +*.exe +*.out +*.app +*.i*86 +*.x86_64 +*.hex + +# Debug files +*.dSYM/ +*.su +*.idb +*.pdb + +# Kernel Module Compile Results +*.mod* +*.cmd +.tmp_versions/ +modules.order +Module.symvers +Mkfile.old +dkms.conf + +### C++ ### +# Prerequisites + +# Compiled Object files +*.slo + +# Precompiled Headers + +# Compiled Dynamic libraries + +# Fortran module files +*.mod +*.smod + +# Compiled Static libraries +*.lai + +# Executables + + +# End of https://www.gitignore.io/api/c,c++ + +# Created by https://www.gitignore.io/api/visualstudiocode + +### VisualStudioCode ### +.vscode/* + + +# End of https://www.gitignore.io/api/visualstudiocode + +# Created by https://www.gitignore.io/api/premake-gmake + +### premake-gmake ### +Makefile +*.make +obj/ + + +# End of https://www.gitignore.io/api/premake-gmake + + +# Created by https://www.gitignore.io/api/visualstudio +# Edit at https://www.gitignore.io/?templates=visualstudio + +### VisualStudio ### +## Ignore Visual Studio temporary files, build results, and +## files generated by popular Visual Studio add-ons. +## +## Get latest from https://github.com/github/gitignore/blob/master/VisualStudio.gitignore + +# User-specific files +*.rsuser +*.suo +*.user +*.userosscache +*.sln.docstates + +# User-specific files (MonoDevelop/Xamarin Studio) +*.userprefs + +# Mono auto generated files +mono_crash.* + +# Build results +[Dd]ebug/ +[Dd]ebugPublic/ +[Rr]elease/ +[Rr]eleases/ +x64/ +x86/ +[Aa][Rr][Mm]/ +[Aa][Rr][Mm]64/ +bld/ +[Bb]in/ +[Oo]bj/ +[Ll]og/ + +# Visual Studio 2015/2017 cache/options directory +.vs/ +# Uncomment if you have tasks that create the project's static files in wwwroot +#wwwroot/ + +# Visual Studio 2017 auto generated files +Generated\ Files/ + +# MSTest test Results +[Tt]est[Rr]esult*/ +[Bb]uild[Ll]og.* + +# NUnit +*.VisualState.xml +TestResult.xml +nunit-*.xml + +# Build Results of an ATL Project +[Dd]ebugPS/ +[Rr]eleasePS/ +dlldata.c + +# Benchmark Results +BenchmarkDotNet.Artifacts/ + +# .NET Core +project.lock.json +project.fragment.lock.json +artifacts/ + +# StyleCop +StyleCopReport.xml + +# Files built by Visual Studio +*_i.c +*_p.c +*_h.h +*.ilk +*.obj +*.iobj +*.pch +*.pdb +*.ipdb +*.pgc +*.pgd +*.rsp +*.sbr +*.tlb +*.tli +*.tlh +*.tmp +*.tmp_proj +*_wpftmp.csproj +*.log +*.vspscc +*.vssscc +.builds +*.pidb +*.svclog +*.scc + +# Chutzpah Test files +_Chutzpah* + +# Visual C++ cache files +ipch/ +*.aps +*.ncb +*.opendb +*.opensdf +*.sdf +*.cachefile +*.VC.db +*.VC.VC.opendb + +# Visual Studio profiler +*.psess +*.vsp +*.vspx +*.sap + +# Visual Studio Trace Files +*.e2e + +# TFS 2012 Local Workspace +$tf/ + +# Guidance Automation Toolkit +*.gpState + +# ReSharper is a .NET coding add-in +_ReSharper*/ +*.[Rr]e[Ss]harper +*.DotSettings.user + +# JustCode is a .NET coding add-in +.JustCode + +# TeamCity is a build add-in +_TeamCity* + +# DotCover is a Code Coverage Tool +*.dotCover + +# AxoCover is a Code Coverage Tool +.axoCover/* +!.axoCover/settings.json + +# Visual Studio code coverage results +*.coverage +*.coveragexml + +# NCrunch +_NCrunch_* +.*crunch*.local.xml +nCrunchTemp_* + +# MightyMoose +*.mm.* +AutoTest.Net/ + +# Web workbench (sass) +.sass-cache/ + +# Installshield output folder +[Ee]xpress/ + +# DocProject is a documentation generator add-in +DocProject/buildhelp/ +DocProject/Help/*.HxT +DocProject/Help/*.HxC +DocProject/Help/*.hhc +DocProject/Help/*.hhk +DocProject/Help/*.hhp +DocProject/Help/Html2 +DocProject/Help/html + +# Click-Once directory +publish/ + +# Publish Web Output +*.[Pp]ublish.xml +*.azurePubxml +# Note: Comment the next line if you want to checkin your web deploy settings, +# but database connection strings (with potential passwords) will be unencrypted +*.pubxml +*.publishproj + +# Microsoft Azure Web App publish settings. Comment the next line if you want to +# checkin your Azure Web App publish settings, but sensitive information contained +# in these scripts will be unencrypted +PublishScripts/ + +# NuGet Packages +*.nupkg +# NuGet Symbol Packages +*.snupkg +# The packages folder can be ignored because of Package Restore +**/[Pp]ackages/* +# except build/, which is used as an MSBuild target. +!**/[Pp]ackages/build/ +# Uncomment if necessary however generally it will be regenerated when needed +#!**/[Pp]ackages/repositories.config +# NuGet v3's project.json files produces more ignorable files +*.nuget.props +*.nuget.targets + +# Microsoft Azure Build Output +csx/ +*.build.csdef + +# Microsoft Azure Emulator +ecf/ +rcf/ + +# Windows Store app package directories and files +AppPackages/ +BundleArtifacts/ +Package.StoreAssociation.xml +_pkginfo.txt +*.appx +*.appxbundle +*.appxupload + +# Visual Studio cache files +# files ending in .cache can be ignored +*.[Cc]ache +# but keep track of directories ending in .cache +!?*.[Cc]ache/ + +# Others +ClientBin/ +~$* +*~ +*.dbmdl +*.dbproj.schemaview +*.jfm +*.pfx +*.publishsettings +orleans.codegen.cs + +# Including strong name files can present a security risk +# (https://github.com/github/gitignore/pull/2483#issue-259490424) +#*.snk + +# Since there are multiple workflows, uncomment next line to ignore bower_components +# (https://github.com/github/gitignore/pull/1529#issuecomment-104372622) +#bower_components/ + +# RIA/Silverlight projects +Generated_Code/ + +# Backup & report files from converting an old project file +# to a newer Visual Studio version. Backup files are not needed, +# because we have git ;-) +_UpgradeReport_Files/ +Backup*/ +UpgradeLog*.XML +UpgradeLog*.htm +ServiceFabricBackup/ +*.rptproj.bak + +# SQL Server files +*.mdf +*.ldf +*.ndf + +# Business Intelligence projects +*.rdl.data +*.bim.layout +*.bim_*.settings +*.rptproj.rsuser +*- [Bb]ackup.rdl +*- [Bb]ackup ([0-9]).rdl +*- [Bb]ackup ([0-9][0-9]).rdl + +# Microsoft Fakes +FakesAssemblies/ + +# GhostDoc plugin setting file +*.GhostDoc.xml + +# Node.js Tools for Visual Studio +.ntvs_analysis.dat +node_modules/ + +# Visual Studio 6 build log +*.plg + +# Visual Studio 6 workspace options file +*.opt + +# Visual Studio 6 auto-generated workspace file (contains which files were open etc.) +*.vbw + +# Visual Studio LightSwitch build output +**/*.HTMLClient/GeneratedArtifacts +**/*.DesktopClient/GeneratedArtifacts +**/*.DesktopClient/ModelManifest.xml +**/*.Server/GeneratedArtifacts +**/*.Server/ModelManifest.xml +_Pvt_Extensions + +# Paket dependency manager +.paket/paket.exe +paket-files/ + +# FAKE - F# Make +.fake/ + +# CodeRush personal settings +.cr/personal + +# Python Tools for Visual Studio (PTVS) +__pycache__/ +*.pyc + +# Cake - Uncomment if you are using it +# tools/** +# !tools/packages.config + +# Tabs Studio +*.tss + +# Telerik's JustMock configuration file +*.jmconfig + +# BizTalk build output +*.btp.cs +*.btm.cs +*.odx.cs +*.xsd.cs + +# OpenCover UI analysis results +OpenCover/ + +# Azure Stream Analytics local run output +ASALocalRun/ + +# MSBuild Binary and Structured Log +*.binlog + +# NVidia Nsight GPU debugger configuration file +*.nvuser + +# MFractors (Xamarin productivity tool) working folder +.mfractor/ + +# Local History for Visual Studio +.localhistory/ + +# BeatPulse healthcheck temp database +healthchecksdb + +# Backup folder for Package Reference Convert tool in Visual Studio 2017 +MigrationBackup/ + +# End of https://www.gitignore.io/api/visualstudio \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/3rdparty/imnodes/LICENSE.md b/3rdparty/imnodes/LICENSE.md new file mode 100644 index 0000000..ac8539e --- /dev/null +++ b/3rdparty/imnodes/LICENSE.md @@ -0,0 +1,21 @@ +MIT License + +Copyright (c) 2019 Johann Muszynski + +Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy +of this software and associated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal +in the Software without restriction, including without limitation the rights +to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell +copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is +furnished to do so, subject to the following conditions: + +The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in all +copies or substantial portions of the Software. + +THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR +IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, +FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE +AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER +LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, +OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE +SOFTWARE. \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/3rdparty/imnodes/README.md b/3rdparty/imnodes/README.md new file mode 100644 index 0000000..7ab3573 --- /dev/null +++ b/3rdparty/imnodes/README.md @@ -0,0 +1,270 @@ +

imnodes

+ +

A small, dependency-free node editor extension for dear imgui.

+ +

+ +

+ +[![Build Status](https://github.com/nelarius/imnodes/workflows/Build/badge.svg)](https://github.com/nelarius/imnodes/actions?workflow=Build) + +Features: + +* Create nodes, links, and pins in an immediate-mode style +* Single header and source file, just copy-paste `imnodes.h`, `imnodes_internal.h`, and `imnodes.cpp` into your project. The only dependency is `dear imgui` itself! +* Written in the same style of C++ as `dear imgui` itself -- no modern C++ used +* Use regular `dear imgui` widgets inside the nodes +* Multiple node and link selection with a box selector +* Nodes, links, and pins are fully customizable, from color style to layout +* Default themes match `dear imgui`'s default themes + +Scroll down for a brief tour, known issues, and further information! + +## Build the examples + +This repository includes a few example files, under `example/`. You can copy-paste them into your own imgui project, or you can build them here, in this repository. To build here: +* SDL2 needs to be installed +* premake5 is used to generate the build files + +```bash +# Assuming you've installed SDL2 via vcpkg, for instance +$ premake5 gmake \ + --sdl-include-path=/Users/nelarius/vcpkg/installed/x64-osx/include/SDL2 \ + --sdl-link-path=/Users/nelarius/vcpkg/installed/x64-osx/lib + +# Or alternatively, if you are on MacOS and have the SDL2 framework installed +$ premake5 gmake --use-sdl-framework + +$ make all -j +``` + +## A brief tour + +Here is a small overview of how the extension is used. For more information on example usage, scroll to the bottom of the README. + +Before anything can be done, the library must be initialized. This can be done at the same time as `dear imgui` initialization. + +```cpp +ImGui::CreateContext(); +ImNodes::CreateContext(); + +// elsewhere in the code... +ImNodes::DestroyContext(); +ImGui::DestroyContext(); +``` + +The node editor is a workspace which contains nodes. The node editor must be instantiated within a window, like any other UI element. + +```cpp +ImGui::Begin("node editor"); + +ImNodes::BeginNodeEditor(); +ImNodes::EndNodeEditor(); + +ImGui::End(); +``` + +Now you should have a workspace with a grid visible in the window. An empty node can now be instantiated: + +```cpp +const int hardcoded_node_id = 1; + +ImNodes::BeginNodeEditor(); + +ImNodes::BeginNode(hardcoded_node_id); +ImGui::Dummy(ImVec2(80.0f, 45.0f)); +ImNodes::EndNode(); + +ImNodes::EndNodeEditor(); +``` + +Nodes, like windows in `dear imgui` must be uniquely identified. But we can't use the node titles for identification, because it should be possible to have many nodes of the same name in the workspace. Instead, you just use integers for identification. + +Attributes are the UI content of the node. An attribute will have a pin (the little circle) on either side of the node. There are two types of attributes: input, and output attributes. Input attribute pins are on the left side of the node, and output attribute pins are on the right. Like nodes, pins must be uniquely identified. + +```cpp +ImNodes::BeginNode(hardcoded_node_id); + +const int output_attr_id = 2; +ImNodes::BeginOutputAttribute(output_attr_id); +// in between Begin|EndAttribute calls, you can call ImGui +// UI functions +ImGui::Text("output pin"); +ImNodes::EndOutputAttribute(); + +ImNodes::EndNode(); +``` + +The extension doesn't really care what is in the attribute. It just renders the pin for the attribute, and allows the user to create links between pins. + +A title bar can be added to the node using `BeginNodeTitleBar` and `EndNodeTitleBar`. Like attributes, you place your title bar's content between the function calls. Note that these functions have to be called before adding attributes or other `dear imgui` UI elements to the node, since the node's layout is built in order, top-to-bottom. + +```cpp +ImNodes::BeginNode(hardcoded_node_id); + +ImNodes::BeginNodeTitleBar(); +ImGui::TextUnformatted("output node"); +ImNodes::EndNodeTitleBar(); + +// pins and other node UI content omitted... + +ImNodes::EndNode(); +``` + +The user has to render their own links between nodes as well. A link is a curve which connects two attributes. A link is just a pair of attribute ids. And like nodes and attributes, links too have to be identified by unique integer values: + +```cpp +std::vector> links; +// elsewhere in the code... +for (int i = 0; i < links.size(); ++i) +{ + const std::pair p = links[i]; + // in this case, we just use the array index of the link + // as the unique identifier + ImNodes::Link(i, p.first, p.second); +} +``` + +After `EndNodeEditor` has been called, you can check if a link was created during the frame with the function call `IsLinkCreated`: + +```cpp +int start_attr, end_attr; +if (ImNodes::IsLinkCreated(&start_attr, &end_attr)) +{ + links.push_back(std::make_pair(start_attr, end_attr)); +} +``` + +In addition to checking for new links, you can also check whether UI elements are being hovered over by the mouse cursor: + +```cpp +int node_id; +if (ImNodes::IsNodeHovered(&node_id)) +{ + node_hovered = node_id; +} +``` + +You can also check to see if any node has been selected. Nodes can be clicked on, or they can be selected by clicking and dragging the box selector over them. + +```cpp +// Note that since many nodes can be selected at once, we first need to query the number of +// selected nodes before getting them. +const int num_selected_nodes = ImNodes::NumSelectedNodes(); +if (num_selected_nodes > 0) +{ + std::vector selected_nodes; + selected_nodes.resize(num_selected_nodes); + ImNodes::GetSelectedNodes(selected_nodes.data()); +} +``` + +See `imnodes.h` for more UI event-related functions. + +Like `dear imgui`, the style of the UI can be changed. You can set the color style of individual nodes, pins, and links mid-frame by calling `ImNodes::PushColorStyle` and `ImNodes::PopColorStyle`. + +```cpp +// set the titlebar color of an individual node +ImNodes::PushColorStyle( + ImNodesCol_TitleBar, IM_COL32(11, 109, 191, 255)); +ImNodes::PushColorStyle( + ImNodesCol_TitleBarSelected, IM_COL32(81, 148, 204, 255)); + +ImNodes::BeginNode(hardcoded_node_id); +// node internals here... +ImNodes::EndNode(); + +ImNodes::PopColorStyle(); +ImNodes::PopColorStyle(); +``` + +If the style is not being set mid-frame, `ImNodes::GetStyle` can be called instead, and the values can be set into the style array directly. + +```cpp +// set the titlebar color for all nodes +ImNodesStyle& style = ImNodes::GetStyle(); +style.colors[ImNodesCol_TitleBar] = IM_COL32(232, 27, 86, 255); +style.colors[ImNodesCol_TitleBarSelected] = IM_COL32(241, 108, 146, 255); +``` + +To handle quicker navigation of large graphs you can use an interactive mini-map overlay. The mini-map can be zoomed and scrolled. Editor nodes will track the panning of the mini-map accordingly. + +```cpp +ImGui::Begin("node editor"); + +ImNodes::BeginNodeEditor(); + +// add nodes... + +// must be called right before EndNodeEditor +ImNodes::MiniMap(); +ImNodes::EndNodeEditor(); + +ImGui::End(); +``` + +The relative sizing and corner location of the mini-map in the editor space can be specified like so: + +```cpp +// MiniMap is a square region with a side length that is 20% the largest editor canvas dimension +// See ImNodesMiniMapLocation_ for other corner locations +ImNodes::MiniMap(0.2f, ImNodesMiniMapLocation_TopRight); +``` + +The mini-map also supports limited node hovering customization through a user-defined callback. +```cpp +// User callback +void mini_map_node_hovering_callback(int node_id, void* user_data) +{ + ImGui::SetTooltip("This is node %d", node_id); +} + +// Later on... +ImNodes::MiniMap(0.2f, ImNodesMiniMapLocation_TopRight, mini_map_node_hovering_callback, custom_user_data); + +// 'custom_user_data' can be used to supply extra information needed for drawing within the callback +``` + +## Customizing ImNodes + +ImNodes can be customized by providing an `imnodes_config.h` header and specifying defining `IMNODES_USER_CONFIG=imnodes_config.h` when compiling. + +It is currently possible to override the type of the minimap hovering callback function. This is useful when generating bindings for another language. + +Here's an example imnodes_config.h, which generates a pybind wrapper for the callback. +```cpp +#pragma once + +#include + +namespace pybind11 { + +inline bool PyWrapper_Check(PyObject *o) { return true; } + +class wrapper : public object { +public: + PYBIND11_OBJECT_DEFAULT(wrapper, object, PyWrapper_Check) + wrapper(void* x) { m_ptr = (PyObject*)x; } + explicit operator bool() const { return m_ptr != nullptr && m_ptr != Py_None; } +}; + +} //namespace pybind11 + +namespace py = pybind11; + +#define ImNodesMiniMapNodeHoveringCallback py::wrapper + +#define ImNodesMiniMapNodeHoveringCallbackUserData py::wrapper +``` + +## Known issues + +* `ImGui::Separator()` spans the current window span. As a result, using a separator inside a node will result in the separator spilling out of the node into the node editor grid. + +## Further information + +See the `examples/` directory to see library usage in greater detail. + +* simple.cpp is a simple hello-world style program which displays two nodes +* save_load.cpp is enables you to add and remove nodes and links, and serializes/deserializes them, so that the program state is retained between restarting the program +* color_node_editor.cpp is a more complete example, which shows how a simple node editor is implemented with a graph. diff --git a/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/gl3w/include/GL/gl3w.h b/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/gl3w/include/GL/gl3w.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000..9430c17 --- /dev/null +++ b/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/gl3w/include/GL/gl3w.h @@ -0,0 +1,1458 @@ +/* + + This file was generated with gl3w_gen.py, part of gl3w + (hosted at https://github.com/skaslev/gl3w) + + This is free and unencumbered software released into the public domain. + + Anyone is free to copy, modify, publish, use, compile, sell, or + distribute this software, either in source code form or as a compiled + binary, for any purpose, commercial or non-commercial, and by any + means. + + In jurisdictions that recognize copyright laws, the author or authors + of this software dedicate any and all copyright interest in the + software to the public domain. We make this dedication for the benefit + of the public at large and to the detriment of our heirs and + successors. We intend this dedication to be an overt act of + relinquishment in perpetuity of all present and future rights to this + software under copyright law. + + THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, + EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF + MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. + IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR + OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, + ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR + OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. + +*/ + +#ifndef __gl3w_h_ +#define __gl3w_h_ + +#include + +#ifndef __gl_h_ +#define __gl_h_ +#endif + +#ifdef __cplusplus +extern "C" { +#endif + +typedef void (*GL3WglProc)(void); + +/* gl3w api */ +int gl3wInit(void); +int gl3wIsSupported(int major, int minor); +GL3WglProc gl3wGetProcAddress(const char *proc); + +/* OpenGL functions */ +extern PFNGLACTIVESHADERPROGRAMPROC gl3wActiveShaderProgram; +extern PFNGLACTIVETEXTUREPROC gl3wActiveTexture; +extern PFNGLATTACHSHADERPROC gl3wAttachShader; +extern PFNGLBEGINCONDITIONALRENDERPROC gl3wBeginConditionalRender; +extern PFNGLBEGINQUERYPROC gl3wBeginQuery; +extern PFNGLBEGINQUERYINDEXEDPROC gl3wBeginQueryIndexed; +extern PFNGLBEGINTRANSFORMFEEDBACKPROC gl3wBeginTransformFeedback; +extern PFNGLBINDATTRIBLOCATIONPROC gl3wBindAttribLocation; +extern PFNGLBINDBUFFERPROC gl3wBindBuffer; +extern PFNGLBINDBUFFERBASEPROC gl3wBindBufferBase; +extern PFNGLBINDBUFFERRANGEPROC gl3wBindBufferRange; +extern PFNGLBINDBUFFERSBASEPROC gl3wBindBuffersBase; +extern PFNGLBINDBUFFERSRANGEPROC gl3wBindBuffersRange; +extern PFNGLBINDFRAGDATALOCATIONPROC gl3wBindFragDataLocation; +extern PFNGLBINDFRAGDATALOCATIONINDEXEDPROC gl3wBindFragDataLocationIndexed; +extern PFNGLBINDFRAMEBUFFERPROC gl3wBindFramebuffer; +extern PFNGLBINDIMAGETEXTUREPROC gl3wBindImageTexture; +extern PFNGLBINDIMAGETEXTURESPROC gl3wBindImageTextures; +extern PFNGLBINDPROGRAMPIPELINEPROC gl3wBindProgramPipeline; +extern PFNGLBINDRENDERBUFFERPROC gl3wBindRenderbuffer; +extern PFNGLBINDSAMPLERPROC gl3wBindSampler; +extern PFNGLBINDSAMPLERSPROC gl3wBindSamplers; +extern PFNGLBINDTEXTUREPROC gl3wBindTexture; +extern PFNGLBINDTEXTUREUNITPROC gl3wBindTextureUnit; +extern PFNGLBINDTEXTURESPROC gl3wBindTextures; +extern PFNGLBINDTRANSFORMFEEDBACKPROC gl3wBindTransformFeedback; +extern PFNGLBINDVERTEXARRAYPROC gl3wBindVertexArray; +extern PFNGLBINDVERTEXBUFFERPROC gl3wBindVertexBuffer; +extern PFNGLBINDVERTEXBUFFERSPROC gl3wBindVertexBuffers; +extern PFNGLBLENDCOLORPROC gl3wBlendColor; +extern PFNGLBLENDEQUATIONPROC gl3wBlendEquation; +extern PFNGLBLENDEQUATIONSEPARATEPROC gl3wBlendEquationSeparate; +extern PFNGLBLENDEQUATIONSEPARATEIPROC gl3wBlendEquationSeparatei; +extern PFNGLBLENDEQUATIONSEPARATEIARBPROC gl3wBlendEquationSeparateiARB; +extern PFNGLBLENDEQUATIONIPROC gl3wBlendEquationi; +extern PFNGLBLENDEQUATIONIARBPROC gl3wBlendEquationiARB; +extern PFNGLBLENDFUNCPROC gl3wBlendFunc; +extern PFNGLBLENDFUNCSEPARATEPROC gl3wBlendFuncSeparate; +extern PFNGLBLENDFUNCSEPARATEIPROC gl3wBlendFuncSeparatei; +extern PFNGLBLENDFUNCSEPARATEIARBPROC gl3wBlendFuncSeparateiARB; +extern PFNGLBLENDFUNCIPROC gl3wBlendFunci; +extern PFNGLBLENDFUNCIARBPROC gl3wBlendFunciARB; +extern PFNGLBLITFRAMEBUFFERPROC gl3wBlitFramebuffer; +extern PFNGLBLITNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERPROC gl3wBlitNamedFramebuffer; +extern PFNGLBUFFERDATAPROC gl3wBufferData; +extern PFNGLBUFFERPAGECOMMITMENTARBPROC gl3wBufferPageCommitmentARB; +extern PFNGLBUFFERSTORAGEPROC gl3wBufferStorage; +extern PFNGLBUFFERSUBDATAPROC gl3wBufferSubData; +extern PFNGLCHECKFRAMEBUFFERSTATUSPROC gl3wCheckFramebufferStatus; +extern PFNGLCHECKNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERSTATUSPROC gl3wCheckNamedFramebufferStatus; +extern PFNGLCLAMPCOLORPROC gl3wClampColor; +extern PFNGLCLEARPROC gl3wClear; +extern PFNGLCLEARBUFFERDATAPROC gl3wClearBufferData; +extern PFNGLCLEARBUFFERSUBDATAPROC gl3wClearBufferSubData; +extern PFNGLCLEARBUFFERFIPROC gl3wClearBufferfi; +extern PFNGLCLEARBUFFERFVPROC gl3wClearBufferfv; +extern PFNGLCLEARBUFFERIVPROC gl3wClearBufferiv; +extern PFNGLCLEARBUFFERUIVPROC gl3wClearBufferuiv; +extern PFNGLCLEARCOLORPROC gl3wClearColor; +extern PFNGLCLEARDEPTHPROC gl3wClearDepth; +extern PFNGLCLEARDEPTHFPROC gl3wClearDepthf; +extern PFNGLCLEARNAMEDBUFFERDATAPROC gl3wClearNamedBufferData; +extern PFNGLCLEARNAMEDBUFFERSUBDATAPROC gl3wClearNamedBufferSubData; +extern PFNGLCLEARNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERFIPROC gl3wClearNamedFramebufferfi; +extern PFNGLCLEARNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERFVPROC gl3wClearNamedFramebufferfv; +extern PFNGLCLEARNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERIVPROC gl3wClearNamedFramebufferiv; +extern PFNGLCLEARNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERUIVPROC gl3wClearNamedFramebufferuiv; +extern PFNGLCLEARSTENCILPROC gl3wClearStencil; +extern PFNGLCLEARTEXIMAGEPROC gl3wClearTexImage; +extern PFNGLCLEARTEXSUBIMAGEPROC gl3wClearTexSubImage; +extern PFNGLCLIENTWAITSYNCPROC gl3wClientWaitSync; +extern PFNGLCLIPCONTROLPROC gl3wClipControl; +extern PFNGLCOLORMASKPROC gl3wColorMask; +extern PFNGLCOLORMASKIPROC gl3wColorMaski; +extern PFNGLCOMPILESHADERPROC gl3wCompileShader; +extern PFNGLCOMPILESHADERINCLUDEARBPROC gl3wCompileShaderIncludeARB; +extern PFNGLCOMPRESSEDTEXIMAGE1DPROC gl3wCompressedTexImage1D; +extern PFNGLCOMPRESSEDTEXIMAGE2DPROC gl3wCompressedTexImage2D; +extern PFNGLCOMPRESSEDTEXIMAGE3DPROC gl3wCompressedTexImage3D; +extern PFNGLCOMPRESSEDTEXSUBIMAGE1DPROC gl3wCompressedTexSubImage1D; +extern PFNGLCOMPRESSEDTEXSUBIMAGE2DPROC gl3wCompressedTexSubImage2D; +extern PFNGLCOMPRESSEDTEXSUBIMAGE3DPROC gl3wCompressedTexSubImage3D; +extern PFNGLCOMPRESSEDTEXTURESUBIMAGE1DPROC gl3wCompressedTextureSubImage1D; +extern PFNGLCOMPRESSEDTEXTURESUBIMAGE2DPROC gl3wCompressedTextureSubImage2D; +extern PFNGLCOMPRESSEDTEXTURESUBIMAGE3DPROC gl3wCompressedTextureSubImage3D; +extern PFNGLCOPYBUFFERSUBDATAPROC gl3wCopyBufferSubData; +extern PFNGLCOPYIMAGESUBDATAPROC gl3wCopyImageSubData; +extern PFNGLCOPYNAMEDBUFFERSUBDATAPROC gl3wCopyNamedBufferSubData; +extern PFNGLCOPYTEXIMAGE1DPROC gl3wCopyTexImage1D; +extern PFNGLCOPYTEXIMAGE2DPROC gl3wCopyTexImage2D; +extern PFNGLCOPYTEXSUBIMAGE1DPROC gl3wCopyTexSubImage1D; +extern PFNGLCOPYTEXSUBIMAGE2DPROC gl3wCopyTexSubImage2D; +extern PFNGLCOPYTEXSUBIMAGE3DPROC gl3wCopyTexSubImage3D; +extern PFNGLCOPYTEXTURESUBIMAGE1DPROC gl3wCopyTextureSubImage1D; +extern PFNGLCOPYTEXTURESUBIMAGE2DPROC gl3wCopyTextureSubImage2D; +extern PFNGLCOPYTEXTURESUBIMAGE3DPROC gl3wCopyTextureSubImage3D; +extern PFNGLCREATEBUFFERSPROC gl3wCreateBuffers; +extern PFNGLCREATEFRAMEBUFFERSPROC gl3wCreateFramebuffers; +extern PFNGLCREATEPROGRAMPROC gl3wCreateProgram; +extern PFNGLCREATEPROGRAMPIPELINESPROC gl3wCreateProgramPipelines; +extern PFNGLCREATEQUERIESPROC gl3wCreateQueries; +extern PFNGLCREATERENDERBUFFERSPROC gl3wCreateRenderbuffers; +extern PFNGLCREATESAMPLERSPROC gl3wCreateSamplers; +extern PFNGLCREATESHADERPROC gl3wCreateShader; +extern PFNGLCREATESHADERPROGRAMVPROC gl3wCreateShaderProgramv; +extern PFNGLCREATESYNCFROMCLEVENTARBPROC gl3wCreateSyncFromCLeventARB; +extern PFNGLCREATETEXTURESPROC gl3wCreateTextures; +extern PFNGLCREATETRANSFORMFEEDBACKSPROC gl3wCreateTransformFeedbacks; +extern PFNGLCREATEVERTEXARRAYSPROC gl3wCreateVertexArrays; +extern PFNGLCULLFACEPROC gl3wCullFace; +extern PFNGLDEBUGMESSAGECALLBACKPROC gl3wDebugMessageCallback; +extern PFNGLDEBUGMESSAGECALLBACKARBPROC gl3wDebugMessageCallbackARB; +extern PFNGLDEBUGMESSAGECONTROLPROC gl3wDebugMessageControl; +extern PFNGLDEBUGMESSAGECONTROLARBPROC gl3wDebugMessageControlARB; +extern PFNGLDEBUGMESSAGEINSERTPROC gl3wDebugMessageInsert; +extern PFNGLDEBUGMESSAGEINSERTARBPROC gl3wDebugMessageInsertARB; +extern PFNGLDELETEBUFFERSPROC gl3wDeleteBuffers; +extern PFNGLDELETEFRAMEBUFFERSPROC gl3wDeleteFramebuffers; +extern PFNGLDELETENAMEDSTRINGARBPROC gl3wDeleteNamedStringARB; +extern PFNGLDELETEPROGRAMPROC gl3wDeleteProgram; +extern PFNGLDELETEPROGRAMPIPELINESPROC gl3wDeleteProgramPipelines; +extern PFNGLDELETEQUERIESPROC gl3wDeleteQueries; +extern PFNGLDELETERENDERBUFFERSPROC gl3wDeleteRenderbuffers; +extern PFNGLDELETESAMPLERSPROC gl3wDeleteSamplers; +extern PFNGLDELETESHADERPROC gl3wDeleteShader; +extern PFNGLDELETESYNCPROC gl3wDeleteSync; +extern PFNGLDELETETEXTURESPROC gl3wDeleteTextures; +extern PFNGLDELETETRANSFORMFEEDBACKSPROC gl3wDeleteTransformFeedbacks; +extern PFNGLDELETEVERTEXARRAYSPROC gl3wDeleteVertexArrays; +extern PFNGLDEPTHFUNCPROC gl3wDepthFunc; +extern PFNGLDEPTHMASKPROC gl3wDepthMask; +extern PFNGLDEPTHRANGEPROC gl3wDepthRange; +extern PFNGLDEPTHRANGEARRAYVPROC gl3wDepthRangeArrayv; +extern PFNGLDEPTHRANGEINDEXEDPROC gl3wDepthRangeIndexed; +extern PFNGLDEPTHRANGEFPROC gl3wDepthRangef; +extern PFNGLDETACHSHADERPROC gl3wDetachShader; +extern PFNGLDISABLEPROC gl3wDisable; +extern PFNGLDISABLEVERTEXARRAYATTRIBPROC gl3wDisableVertexArrayAttrib; +extern PFNGLDISABLEVERTEXATTRIBARRAYPROC gl3wDisableVertexAttribArray; +extern PFNGLDISABLEIPROC gl3wDisablei; +extern PFNGLDISPATCHCOMPUTEPROC gl3wDispatchCompute; +extern PFNGLDISPATCHCOMPUTEGROUPSIZEARBPROC gl3wDispatchComputeGroupSizeARB; +extern PFNGLDISPATCHCOMPUTEINDIRECTPROC gl3wDispatchComputeIndirect; +extern PFNGLDRAWARRAYSPROC gl3wDrawArrays; +extern PFNGLDRAWARRAYSINDIRECTPROC gl3wDrawArraysIndirect; +extern PFNGLDRAWARRAYSINSTANCEDPROC gl3wDrawArraysInstanced; +extern PFNGLDRAWARRAYSINSTANCEDBASEINSTANCEPROC gl3wDrawArraysInstancedBaseInstance; +extern PFNGLDRAWBUFFERPROC gl3wDrawBuffer; +extern PFNGLDRAWBUFFERSPROC gl3wDrawBuffers; +extern PFNGLDRAWELEMENTSPROC gl3wDrawElements; +extern PFNGLDRAWELEMENTSBASEVERTEXPROC gl3wDrawElementsBaseVertex; +extern PFNGLDRAWELEMENTSINDIRECTPROC gl3wDrawElementsIndirect; +extern PFNGLDRAWELEMENTSINSTANCEDPROC gl3wDrawElementsInstanced; +extern PFNGLDRAWELEMENTSINSTANCEDBASEINSTANCEPROC gl3wDrawElementsInstancedBaseInstance; +extern PFNGLDRAWELEMENTSINSTANCEDBASEVERTEXPROC gl3wDrawElementsInstancedBaseVertex; +extern PFNGLDRAWELEMENTSINSTANCEDBASEVERTEXBASEINSTANCEPROC gl3wDrawElementsInstancedBaseVertexBaseInstance; +extern PFNGLDRAWRANGEELEMENTSPROC gl3wDrawRangeElements; +extern PFNGLDRAWRANGEELEMENTSBASEVERTEXPROC gl3wDrawRangeElementsBaseVertex; +extern PFNGLDRAWTRANSFORMFEEDBACKPROC gl3wDrawTransformFeedback; +extern PFNGLDRAWTRANSFORMFEEDBACKINSTANCEDPROC gl3wDrawTransformFeedbackInstanced; +extern PFNGLDRAWTRANSFORMFEEDBACKSTREAMPROC gl3wDrawTransformFeedbackStream; +extern PFNGLDRAWTRANSFORMFEEDBACKSTREAMINSTANCEDPROC gl3wDrawTransformFeedbackStreamInstanced; +extern PFNGLENABLEPROC gl3wEnable; +extern PFNGLENABLEVERTEXARRAYATTRIBPROC gl3wEnableVertexArrayAttrib; +extern PFNGLENABLEVERTEXATTRIBARRAYPROC gl3wEnableVertexAttribArray; +extern PFNGLENABLEIPROC gl3wEnablei; +extern PFNGLENDCONDITIONALRENDERPROC gl3wEndConditionalRender; +extern PFNGLENDQUERYPROC gl3wEndQuery; +extern PFNGLENDQUERYINDEXEDPROC gl3wEndQueryIndexed; +extern PFNGLENDTRANSFORMFEEDBACKPROC gl3wEndTransformFeedback; +extern PFNGLFENCESYNCPROC gl3wFenceSync; +extern PFNGLFINISHPROC gl3wFinish; +extern PFNGLFLUSHPROC gl3wFlush; +extern PFNGLFLUSHMAPPEDBUFFERRANGEPROC gl3wFlushMappedBufferRange; +extern PFNGLFLUSHMAPPEDNAMEDBUFFERRANGEPROC gl3wFlushMappedNamedBufferRange; +extern PFNGLFRAMEBUFFERPARAMETERIPROC gl3wFramebufferParameteri; +extern PFNGLFRAMEBUFFERRENDERBUFFERPROC gl3wFramebufferRenderbuffer; +extern PFNGLFRAMEBUFFERTEXTUREPROC gl3wFramebufferTexture; +extern PFNGLFRAMEBUFFERTEXTURE1DPROC gl3wFramebufferTexture1D; +extern PFNGLFRAMEBUFFERTEXTURE2DPROC gl3wFramebufferTexture2D; +extern PFNGLFRAMEBUFFERTEXTURE3DPROC gl3wFramebufferTexture3D; +extern PFNGLFRAMEBUFFERTEXTURELAYERPROC gl3wFramebufferTextureLayer; +extern PFNGLFRONTFACEPROC gl3wFrontFace; +extern PFNGLGENBUFFERSPROC gl3wGenBuffers; +extern PFNGLGENFRAMEBUFFERSPROC gl3wGenFramebuffers; +extern PFNGLGENPROGRAMPIPELINESPROC gl3wGenProgramPipelines; +extern PFNGLGENQUERIESPROC gl3wGenQueries; +extern PFNGLGENRENDERBUFFERSPROC gl3wGenRenderbuffers; +extern PFNGLGENSAMPLERSPROC gl3wGenSamplers; +extern PFNGLGENTEXTURESPROC gl3wGenTextures; +extern PFNGLGENTRANSFORMFEEDBACKSPROC gl3wGenTransformFeedbacks; +extern PFNGLGENVERTEXARRAYSPROC gl3wGenVertexArrays; +extern PFNGLGENERATEMIPMAPPROC gl3wGenerateMipmap; +extern PFNGLGENERATETEXTUREMIPMAPPROC gl3wGenerateTextureMipmap; +extern PFNGLGETACTIVEATOMICCOUNTERBUFFERIVPROC gl3wGetActiveAtomicCounterBufferiv; +extern PFNGLGETACTIVEATTRIBPROC gl3wGetActiveAttrib; +extern PFNGLGETACTIVESUBROUTINENAMEPROC gl3wGetActiveSubroutineName; +extern PFNGLGETACTIVESUBROUTINEUNIFORMNAMEPROC gl3wGetActiveSubroutineUniformName; +extern PFNGLGETACTIVESUBROUTINEUNIFORMIVPROC gl3wGetActiveSubroutineUniformiv; +extern PFNGLGETACTIVEUNIFORMPROC gl3wGetActiveUniform; +extern PFNGLGETACTIVEUNIFORMBLOCKNAMEPROC gl3wGetActiveUniformBlockName; +extern PFNGLGETACTIVEUNIFORMBLOCKIVPROC gl3wGetActiveUniformBlockiv; +extern PFNGLGETACTIVEUNIFORMNAMEPROC gl3wGetActiveUniformName; +extern PFNGLGETACTIVEUNIFORMSIVPROC gl3wGetActiveUniformsiv; +extern PFNGLGETATTACHEDSHADERSPROC gl3wGetAttachedShaders; +extern PFNGLGETATTRIBLOCATIONPROC gl3wGetAttribLocation; +extern PFNGLGETBOOLEANI_VPROC gl3wGetBooleani_v; +extern PFNGLGETBOOLEANVPROC gl3wGetBooleanv; +extern PFNGLGETBUFFERPARAMETERI64VPROC gl3wGetBufferParameteri64v; +extern PFNGLGETBUFFERPARAMETERIVPROC gl3wGetBufferParameteriv; +extern PFNGLGETBUFFERPOINTERVPROC gl3wGetBufferPointerv; +extern PFNGLGETBUFFERSUBDATAPROC gl3wGetBufferSubData; +extern PFNGLGETCOMPRESSEDTEXIMAGEPROC gl3wGetCompressedTexImage; +extern PFNGLGETCOMPRESSEDTEXTUREIMAGEPROC gl3wGetCompressedTextureImage; +extern PFNGLGETCOMPRESSEDTEXTURESUBIMAGEPROC gl3wGetCompressedTextureSubImage; +extern PFNGLGETDEBUGMESSAGELOGPROC gl3wGetDebugMessageLog; +extern PFNGLGETDEBUGMESSAGELOGARBPROC gl3wGetDebugMessageLogARB; +extern PFNGLGETDOUBLEI_VPROC gl3wGetDoublei_v; +extern PFNGLGETDOUBLEVPROC gl3wGetDoublev; +extern PFNGLGETERRORPROC gl3wGetError; +extern PFNGLGETFLOATI_VPROC gl3wGetFloati_v; +extern PFNGLGETFLOATVPROC gl3wGetFloatv; +extern PFNGLGETFRAGDATAINDEXPROC gl3wGetFragDataIndex; +extern PFNGLGETFRAGDATALOCATIONPROC gl3wGetFragDataLocation; +extern PFNGLGETFRAMEBUFFERATTACHMENTPARAMETERIVPROC gl3wGetFramebufferAttachmentParameteriv; +extern PFNGLGETFRAMEBUFFERPARAMETERIVPROC gl3wGetFramebufferParameteriv; +extern PFNGLGETGRAPHICSRESETSTATUSPROC gl3wGetGraphicsResetStatus; +extern PFNGLGETGRAPHICSRESETSTATUSARBPROC gl3wGetGraphicsResetStatusARB; +extern PFNGLGETIMAGEHANDLEARBPROC gl3wGetImageHandleARB; +extern PFNGLGETINTEGER64I_VPROC gl3wGetInteger64i_v; +extern PFNGLGETINTEGER64VPROC gl3wGetInteger64v; +extern PFNGLGETINTEGERI_VPROC gl3wGetIntegeri_v; +extern PFNGLGETINTEGERVPROC gl3wGetIntegerv; +extern PFNGLGETINTERNALFORMATI64VPROC gl3wGetInternalformati64v; +extern PFNGLGETINTERNALFORMATIVPROC gl3wGetInternalformativ; +extern PFNGLGETMULTISAMPLEFVPROC gl3wGetMultisamplefv; +extern PFNGLGETNAMEDBUFFERPARAMETERI64VPROC gl3wGetNamedBufferParameteri64v; +extern PFNGLGETNAMEDBUFFERPARAMETERIVPROC gl3wGetNamedBufferParameteriv; +extern PFNGLGETNAMEDBUFFERPOINTERVPROC gl3wGetNamedBufferPointerv; +extern PFNGLGETNAMEDBUFFERSUBDATAPROC gl3wGetNamedBufferSubData; +extern PFNGLGETNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERATTACHMENTPARAMETERIVPROC gl3wGetNamedFramebufferAttachmentParameteriv; +extern PFNGLGETNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERPARAMETERIVPROC gl3wGetNamedFramebufferParameteriv; +extern PFNGLGETNAMEDRENDERBUFFERPARAMETERIVPROC gl3wGetNamedRenderbufferParameteriv; +extern PFNGLGETNAMEDSTRINGARBPROC gl3wGetNamedStringARB; +extern PFNGLGETNAMEDSTRINGIVARBPROC gl3wGetNamedStringivARB; +extern PFNGLGETOBJECTLABELPROC gl3wGetObjectLabel; +extern PFNGLGETOBJECTPTRLABELPROC gl3wGetObjectPtrLabel; +extern PFNGLGETPOINTERVPROC gl3wGetPointerv; +extern PFNGLGETPROGRAMBINARYPROC gl3wGetProgramBinary; +extern PFNGLGETPROGRAMINFOLOGPROC gl3wGetProgramInfoLog; +extern PFNGLGETPROGRAMINTERFACEIVPROC gl3wGetProgramInterfaceiv; +extern PFNGLGETPROGRAMPIPELINEINFOLOGPROC gl3wGetProgramPipelineInfoLog; +extern PFNGLGETPROGRAMPIPELINEIVPROC gl3wGetProgramPipelineiv; +extern PFNGLGETPROGRAMRESOURCEINDEXPROC gl3wGetProgramResourceIndex; +extern PFNGLGETPROGRAMRESOURCELOCATIONPROC gl3wGetProgramResourceLocation; +extern PFNGLGETPROGRAMRESOURCELOCATIONINDEXPROC gl3wGetProgramResourceLocationIndex; +extern PFNGLGETPROGRAMRESOURCENAMEPROC gl3wGetProgramResourceName; +extern PFNGLGETPROGRAMRESOURCEIVPROC gl3wGetProgramResourceiv; +extern PFNGLGETPROGRAMSTAGEIVPROC gl3wGetProgramStageiv; +extern PFNGLGETPROGRAMIVPROC gl3wGetProgramiv; +extern PFNGLGETQUERYBUFFEROBJECTI64VPROC gl3wGetQueryBufferObjecti64v; +extern PFNGLGETQUERYBUFFEROBJECTIVPROC gl3wGetQueryBufferObjectiv; +extern PFNGLGETQUERYBUFFEROBJECTUI64VPROC gl3wGetQueryBufferObjectui64v; +extern PFNGLGETQUERYBUFFEROBJECTUIVPROC gl3wGetQueryBufferObjectuiv; +extern PFNGLGETQUERYINDEXEDIVPROC gl3wGetQueryIndexediv; +extern PFNGLGETQUERYOBJECTI64VPROC gl3wGetQueryObjecti64v; +extern PFNGLGETQUERYOBJECTIVPROC gl3wGetQueryObjectiv; +extern PFNGLGETQUERYOBJECTUI64VPROC gl3wGetQueryObjectui64v; +extern PFNGLGETQUERYOBJECTUIVPROC gl3wGetQueryObjectuiv; +extern PFNGLGETQUERYIVPROC gl3wGetQueryiv; +extern PFNGLGETRENDERBUFFERPARAMETERIVPROC gl3wGetRenderbufferParameteriv; +extern PFNGLGETSAMPLERPARAMETERIIVPROC gl3wGetSamplerParameterIiv; +extern PFNGLGETSAMPLERPARAMETERIUIVPROC gl3wGetSamplerParameterIuiv; +extern PFNGLGETSAMPLERPARAMETERFVPROC gl3wGetSamplerParameterfv; +extern PFNGLGETSAMPLERPARAMETERIVPROC gl3wGetSamplerParameteriv; +extern PFNGLGETSHADERINFOLOGPROC gl3wGetShaderInfoLog; +extern PFNGLGETSHADERPRECISIONFORMATPROC gl3wGetShaderPrecisionFormat; +extern PFNGLGETSHADERSOURCEPROC gl3wGetShaderSource; +extern PFNGLGETSHADERIVPROC gl3wGetShaderiv; +extern PFNGLGETSTRINGPROC gl3wGetString; +extern PFNGLGETSTRINGIPROC gl3wGetStringi; +extern PFNGLGETSUBROUTINEINDEXPROC gl3wGetSubroutineIndex; +extern PFNGLGETSUBROUTINEUNIFORMLOCATIONPROC gl3wGetSubroutineUniformLocation; +extern PFNGLGETSYNCIVPROC gl3wGetSynciv; +extern PFNGLGETTEXIMAGEPROC gl3wGetTexImage; +extern PFNGLGETTEXLEVELPARAMETERFVPROC gl3wGetTexLevelParameterfv; +extern PFNGLGETTEXLEVELPARAMETERIVPROC gl3wGetTexLevelParameteriv; +extern PFNGLGETTEXPARAMETERIIVPROC gl3wGetTexParameterIiv; +extern PFNGLGETTEXPARAMETERIUIVPROC gl3wGetTexParameterIuiv; +extern PFNGLGETTEXPARAMETERFVPROC gl3wGetTexParameterfv; +extern PFNGLGETTEXPARAMETERIVPROC gl3wGetTexParameteriv; +extern PFNGLGETTEXTUREHANDLEARBPROC gl3wGetTextureHandleARB; +extern PFNGLGETTEXTUREIMAGEPROC gl3wGetTextureImage; +extern PFNGLGETTEXTURELEVELPARAMETERFVPROC gl3wGetTextureLevelParameterfv; +extern PFNGLGETTEXTURELEVELPARAMETERIVPROC gl3wGetTextureLevelParameteriv; +extern PFNGLGETTEXTUREPARAMETERIIVPROC gl3wGetTextureParameterIiv; +extern PFNGLGETTEXTUREPARAMETERIUIVPROC gl3wGetTextureParameterIuiv; +extern PFNGLGETTEXTUREPARAMETERFVPROC gl3wGetTextureParameterfv; +extern PFNGLGETTEXTUREPARAMETERIVPROC gl3wGetTextureParameteriv; +extern PFNGLGETTEXTURESAMPLERHANDLEARBPROC gl3wGetTextureSamplerHandleARB; +extern PFNGLGETTEXTURESUBIMAGEPROC gl3wGetTextureSubImage; +extern PFNGLGETTRANSFORMFEEDBACKVARYINGPROC gl3wGetTransformFeedbackVarying; +extern PFNGLGETTRANSFORMFEEDBACKI64_VPROC gl3wGetTransformFeedbacki64_v; +extern PFNGLGETTRANSFORMFEEDBACKI_VPROC gl3wGetTransformFeedbacki_v; +extern PFNGLGETTRANSFORMFEEDBACKIVPROC gl3wGetTransformFeedbackiv; +extern PFNGLGETUNIFORMBLOCKINDEXPROC gl3wGetUniformBlockIndex; +extern PFNGLGETUNIFORMINDICESPROC gl3wGetUniformIndices; +extern PFNGLGETUNIFORMLOCATIONPROC gl3wGetUniformLocation; +extern PFNGLGETUNIFORMSUBROUTINEUIVPROC gl3wGetUniformSubroutineuiv; +extern PFNGLGETUNIFORMDVPROC gl3wGetUniformdv; +extern PFNGLGETUNIFORMFVPROC gl3wGetUniformfv; +extern PFNGLGETUNIFORMIVPROC gl3wGetUniformiv; +extern PFNGLGETUNIFORMUIVPROC gl3wGetUniformuiv; +extern PFNGLGETVERTEXARRAYINDEXED64IVPROC gl3wGetVertexArrayIndexed64iv; +extern PFNGLGETVERTEXARRAYINDEXEDIVPROC gl3wGetVertexArrayIndexediv; +extern PFNGLGETVERTEXARRAYIVPROC gl3wGetVertexArrayiv; +extern PFNGLGETVERTEXATTRIBIIVPROC gl3wGetVertexAttribIiv; +extern PFNGLGETVERTEXATTRIBIUIVPROC gl3wGetVertexAttribIuiv; +extern PFNGLGETVERTEXATTRIBLDVPROC gl3wGetVertexAttribLdv; +extern PFNGLGETVERTEXATTRIBLUI64VARBPROC gl3wGetVertexAttribLui64vARB; +extern PFNGLGETVERTEXATTRIBPOINTERVPROC gl3wGetVertexAttribPointerv; +extern PFNGLGETVERTEXATTRIBDVPROC gl3wGetVertexAttribdv; +extern PFNGLGETVERTEXATTRIBFVPROC gl3wGetVertexAttribfv; +extern PFNGLGETVERTEXATTRIBIVPROC gl3wGetVertexAttribiv; +extern PFNGLGETNCOMPRESSEDTEXIMAGEPROC gl3wGetnCompressedTexImage; +extern PFNGLGETNCOMPRESSEDTEXIMAGEARBPROC gl3wGetnCompressedTexImageARB; +extern PFNGLGETNTEXIMAGEPROC gl3wGetnTexImage; +extern PFNGLGETNTEXIMAGEARBPROC gl3wGetnTexImageARB; +extern PFNGLGETNUNIFORMDVPROC gl3wGetnUniformdv; +extern PFNGLGETNUNIFORMDVARBPROC gl3wGetnUniformdvARB; +extern PFNGLGETNUNIFORMFVPROC gl3wGetnUniformfv; +extern PFNGLGETNUNIFORMFVARBPROC gl3wGetnUniformfvARB; +extern PFNGLGETNUNIFORMIVPROC gl3wGetnUniformiv; +extern PFNGLGETNUNIFORMIVARBPROC gl3wGetnUniformivARB; +extern PFNGLGETNUNIFORMUIVPROC gl3wGetnUniformuiv; +extern PFNGLGETNUNIFORMUIVARBPROC gl3wGetnUniformuivARB; +extern PFNGLHINTPROC gl3wHint; +extern PFNGLINVALIDATEBUFFERDATAPROC gl3wInvalidateBufferData; +extern PFNGLINVALIDATEBUFFERSUBDATAPROC gl3wInvalidateBufferSubData; +extern PFNGLINVALIDATEFRAMEBUFFERPROC gl3wInvalidateFramebuffer; +extern PFNGLINVALIDATENAMEDFRAMEBUFFERDATAPROC gl3wInvalidateNamedFramebufferData; +extern PFNGLINVALIDATENAMEDFRAMEBUFFERSUBDATAPROC gl3wInvalidateNamedFramebufferSubData; +extern PFNGLINVALIDATESUBFRAMEBUFFERPROC gl3wInvalidateSubFramebuffer; +extern PFNGLINVALIDATETEXIMAGEPROC gl3wInvalidateTexImage; +extern PFNGLINVALIDATETEXSUBIMAGEPROC gl3wInvalidateTexSubImage; +extern PFNGLISBUFFERPROC gl3wIsBuffer; +extern PFNGLISENABLEDPROC gl3wIsEnabled; +extern PFNGLISENABLEDIPROC gl3wIsEnabledi; +extern PFNGLISFRAMEBUFFERPROC gl3wIsFramebuffer; +extern PFNGLISIMAGEHANDLERESIDENTARBPROC gl3wIsImageHandleResidentARB; +extern PFNGLISNAMEDSTRINGARBPROC gl3wIsNamedStringARB; +extern PFNGLISPROGRAMPROC gl3wIsProgram; +extern PFNGLISPROGRAMPIPELINEPROC gl3wIsProgramPipeline; +extern PFNGLISQUERYPROC gl3wIsQuery; +extern PFNGLISRENDERBUFFERPROC gl3wIsRenderbuffer; +extern PFNGLISSAMPLERPROC gl3wIsSampler; +extern PFNGLISSHADERPROC gl3wIsShader; +extern PFNGLISSYNCPROC gl3wIsSync; +extern PFNGLISTEXTUREPROC gl3wIsTexture; +extern PFNGLISTEXTUREHANDLERESIDENTARBPROC gl3wIsTextureHandleResidentARB; +extern PFNGLISTRANSFORMFEEDBACKPROC gl3wIsTransformFeedback; +extern PFNGLISVERTEXARRAYPROC gl3wIsVertexArray; +extern PFNGLLINEWIDTHPROC gl3wLineWidth; +extern PFNGLLINKPROGRAMPROC gl3wLinkProgram; +extern PFNGLLOGICOPPROC gl3wLogicOp; +extern PFNGLMAKEIMAGEHANDLENONRESIDENTARBPROC gl3wMakeImageHandleNonResidentARB; +extern PFNGLMAKEIMAGEHANDLERESIDENTARBPROC gl3wMakeImageHandleResidentARB; +extern PFNGLMAKETEXTUREHANDLENONRESIDENTARBPROC gl3wMakeTextureHandleNonResidentARB; +extern PFNGLMAKETEXTUREHANDLERESIDENTARBPROC gl3wMakeTextureHandleResidentARB; +extern PFNGLMAPBUFFERPROC gl3wMapBuffer; +extern PFNGLMAPBUFFERRANGEPROC gl3wMapBufferRange; +extern PFNGLMAPNAMEDBUFFERPROC gl3wMapNamedBuffer; +extern PFNGLMAPNAMEDBUFFERRANGEPROC gl3wMapNamedBufferRange; +extern PFNGLMEMORYBARRIERPROC gl3wMemoryBarrier; +extern PFNGLMEMORYBARRIERBYREGIONPROC gl3wMemoryBarrierByRegion; +extern PFNGLMINSAMPLESHADINGPROC gl3wMinSampleShading; +extern PFNGLMINSAMPLESHADINGARBPROC gl3wMinSampleShadingARB; +extern PFNGLMULTIDRAWARRAYSPROC gl3wMultiDrawArrays; +extern PFNGLMULTIDRAWARRAYSINDIRECTPROC gl3wMultiDrawArraysIndirect; +extern PFNGLMULTIDRAWARRAYSINDIRECTCOUNTARBPROC gl3wMultiDrawArraysIndirectCountARB; +extern PFNGLMULTIDRAWELEMENTSPROC gl3wMultiDrawElements; +extern PFNGLMULTIDRAWELEMENTSBASEVERTEXPROC gl3wMultiDrawElementsBaseVertex; +extern PFNGLMULTIDRAWELEMENTSINDIRECTPROC gl3wMultiDrawElementsIndirect; +extern PFNGLMULTIDRAWELEMENTSINDIRECTCOUNTARBPROC gl3wMultiDrawElementsIndirectCountARB; +extern PFNGLNAMEDBUFFERDATAPROC gl3wNamedBufferData; +extern PFNGLNAMEDBUFFERPAGECOMMITMENTARBPROC gl3wNamedBufferPageCommitmentARB; +extern PFNGLNAMEDBUFFERPAGECOMMITMENTEXTPROC gl3wNamedBufferPageCommitmentEXT; +extern PFNGLNAMEDBUFFERSTORAGEPROC gl3wNamedBufferStorage; +extern PFNGLNAMEDBUFFERSUBDATAPROC gl3wNamedBufferSubData; +extern PFNGLNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERDRAWBUFFERPROC gl3wNamedFramebufferDrawBuffer; +extern PFNGLNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERDRAWBUFFERSPROC gl3wNamedFramebufferDrawBuffers; +extern PFNGLNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERPARAMETERIPROC gl3wNamedFramebufferParameteri; +extern PFNGLNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERREADBUFFERPROC gl3wNamedFramebufferReadBuffer; +extern PFNGLNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERRENDERBUFFERPROC gl3wNamedFramebufferRenderbuffer; +extern PFNGLNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERTEXTUREPROC gl3wNamedFramebufferTexture; +extern PFNGLNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERTEXTURELAYERPROC gl3wNamedFramebufferTextureLayer; +extern PFNGLNAMEDRENDERBUFFERSTORAGEPROC gl3wNamedRenderbufferStorage; +extern PFNGLNAMEDRENDERBUFFERSTORAGEMULTISAMPLEPROC gl3wNamedRenderbufferStorageMultisample; +extern PFNGLNAMEDSTRINGARBPROC gl3wNamedStringARB; +extern PFNGLOBJECTLABELPROC gl3wObjectLabel; +extern PFNGLOBJECTPTRLABELPROC gl3wObjectPtrLabel; +extern PFNGLPATCHPARAMETERFVPROC gl3wPatchParameterfv; +extern PFNGLPATCHPARAMETERIPROC gl3wPatchParameteri; +extern PFNGLPAUSETRANSFORMFEEDBACKPROC gl3wPauseTransformFeedback; +extern PFNGLPIXELSTOREFPROC gl3wPixelStoref; +extern PFNGLPIXELSTOREIPROC gl3wPixelStorei; +extern PFNGLPOINTPARAMETERFPROC gl3wPointParameterf; +extern PFNGLPOINTPARAMETERFVPROC gl3wPointParameterfv; +extern PFNGLPOINTPARAMETERIPROC gl3wPointParameteri; +extern PFNGLPOINTPARAMETERIVPROC gl3wPointParameteriv; +extern PFNGLPOINTSIZEPROC gl3wPointSize; +extern PFNGLPOLYGONMODEPROC gl3wPolygonMode; +extern PFNGLPOLYGONOFFSETPROC gl3wPolygonOffset; +extern PFNGLPOPDEBUGGROUPPROC gl3wPopDebugGroup; +extern PFNGLPRIMITIVERESTARTINDEXPROC gl3wPrimitiveRestartIndex; +extern PFNGLPROGRAMBINARYPROC gl3wProgramBinary; +extern PFNGLPROGRAMPARAMETERIPROC gl3wProgramParameteri; +extern PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM1DPROC gl3wProgramUniform1d; +extern PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM1DVPROC gl3wProgramUniform1dv; +extern PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM1FPROC gl3wProgramUniform1f; +extern PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM1FVPROC gl3wProgramUniform1fv; +extern PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM1IPROC gl3wProgramUniform1i; +extern PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM1IVPROC gl3wProgramUniform1iv; +extern PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM1UIPROC gl3wProgramUniform1ui; +extern PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM1UIVPROC gl3wProgramUniform1uiv; +extern PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM2DPROC gl3wProgramUniform2d; +extern PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM2DVPROC gl3wProgramUniform2dv; +extern PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM2FPROC gl3wProgramUniform2f; +extern PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM2FVPROC gl3wProgramUniform2fv; +extern PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM2IPROC gl3wProgramUniform2i; +extern PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM2IVPROC gl3wProgramUniform2iv; +extern PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM2UIPROC gl3wProgramUniform2ui; +extern PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM2UIVPROC gl3wProgramUniform2uiv; +extern PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM3DPROC gl3wProgramUniform3d; +extern PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM3DVPROC gl3wProgramUniform3dv; +extern PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM3FPROC gl3wProgramUniform3f; +extern PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM3FVPROC gl3wProgramUniform3fv; +extern PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM3IPROC gl3wProgramUniform3i; +extern PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM3IVPROC gl3wProgramUniform3iv; +extern PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM3UIPROC gl3wProgramUniform3ui; +extern PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM3UIVPROC gl3wProgramUniform3uiv; +extern PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM4DPROC gl3wProgramUniform4d; +extern PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM4DVPROC gl3wProgramUniform4dv; +extern PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM4FPROC gl3wProgramUniform4f; +extern PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM4FVPROC gl3wProgramUniform4fv; +extern PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM4IPROC gl3wProgramUniform4i; +extern PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM4IVPROC gl3wProgramUniform4iv; +extern PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM4UIPROC gl3wProgramUniform4ui; +extern PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM4UIVPROC gl3wProgramUniform4uiv; +extern PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMHANDLEUI64ARBPROC gl3wProgramUniformHandleui64ARB; +extern PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMHANDLEUI64VARBPROC gl3wProgramUniformHandleui64vARB; +extern PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX2DVPROC gl3wProgramUniformMatrix2dv; +extern PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX2FVPROC gl3wProgramUniformMatrix2fv; +extern PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX2X3DVPROC gl3wProgramUniformMatrix2x3dv; +extern PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX2X3FVPROC gl3wProgramUniformMatrix2x3fv; +extern PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX2X4DVPROC gl3wProgramUniformMatrix2x4dv; +extern PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX2X4FVPROC gl3wProgramUniformMatrix2x4fv; +extern PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX3DVPROC gl3wProgramUniformMatrix3dv; +extern PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX3FVPROC gl3wProgramUniformMatrix3fv; +extern PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX3X2DVPROC gl3wProgramUniformMatrix3x2dv; +extern PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX3X2FVPROC gl3wProgramUniformMatrix3x2fv; +extern PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX3X4DVPROC gl3wProgramUniformMatrix3x4dv; +extern PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX3X4FVPROC gl3wProgramUniformMatrix3x4fv; +extern PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX4DVPROC gl3wProgramUniformMatrix4dv; +extern PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX4FVPROC gl3wProgramUniformMatrix4fv; +extern PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX4X2DVPROC gl3wProgramUniformMatrix4x2dv; +extern PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX4X2FVPROC gl3wProgramUniformMatrix4x2fv; +extern PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX4X3DVPROC gl3wProgramUniformMatrix4x3dv; +extern PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX4X3FVPROC gl3wProgramUniformMatrix4x3fv; +extern PFNGLPROVOKINGVERTEXPROC gl3wProvokingVertex; +extern PFNGLPUSHDEBUGGROUPPROC gl3wPushDebugGroup; +extern PFNGLQUERYCOUNTERPROC gl3wQueryCounter; +extern PFNGLREADBUFFERPROC gl3wReadBuffer; +extern PFNGLREADPIXELSPROC gl3wReadPixels; +extern PFNGLREADNPIXELSPROC gl3wReadnPixels; +extern PFNGLREADNPIXELSARBPROC gl3wReadnPixelsARB; +extern PFNGLRELEASESHADERCOMPILERPROC gl3wReleaseShaderCompiler; +extern PFNGLRENDERBUFFERSTORAGEPROC gl3wRenderbufferStorage; +extern PFNGLRENDERBUFFERSTORAGEMULTISAMPLEPROC gl3wRenderbufferStorageMultisample; +extern PFNGLRESUMETRANSFORMFEEDBACKPROC gl3wResumeTransformFeedback; +extern PFNGLSAMPLECOVERAGEPROC gl3wSampleCoverage; +extern PFNGLSAMPLEMASKIPROC gl3wSampleMaski; +extern PFNGLSAMPLERPARAMETERIIVPROC gl3wSamplerParameterIiv; +extern PFNGLSAMPLERPARAMETERIUIVPROC gl3wSamplerParameterIuiv; +extern PFNGLSAMPLERPARAMETERFPROC gl3wSamplerParameterf; +extern PFNGLSAMPLERPARAMETERFVPROC gl3wSamplerParameterfv; +extern PFNGLSAMPLERPARAMETERIPROC gl3wSamplerParameteri; +extern PFNGLSAMPLERPARAMETERIVPROC gl3wSamplerParameteriv; +extern PFNGLSCISSORPROC gl3wScissor; +extern PFNGLSCISSORARRAYVPROC gl3wScissorArrayv; +extern PFNGLSCISSORINDEXEDPROC gl3wScissorIndexed; +extern PFNGLSCISSORINDEXEDVPROC gl3wScissorIndexedv; +extern PFNGLSHADERBINARYPROC gl3wShaderBinary; +extern PFNGLSHADERSOURCEPROC gl3wShaderSource; +extern PFNGLSHADERSTORAGEBLOCKBINDINGPROC gl3wShaderStorageBlockBinding; +extern PFNGLSTENCILFUNCPROC gl3wStencilFunc; +extern PFNGLSTENCILFUNCSEPARATEPROC gl3wStencilFuncSeparate; +extern PFNGLSTENCILMASKPROC gl3wStencilMask; +extern PFNGLSTENCILMASKSEPARATEPROC gl3wStencilMaskSeparate; +extern PFNGLSTENCILOPPROC gl3wStencilOp; +extern PFNGLSTENCILOPSEPARATEPROC gl3wStencilOpSeparate; +extern PFNGLTEXBUFFERPROC gl3wTexBuffer; +extern PFNGLTEXBUFFERRANGEPROC gl3wTexBufferRange; +extern PFNGLTEXIMAGE1DPROC gl3wTexImage1D; +extern PFNGLTEXIMAGE2DPROC gl3wTexImage2D; +extern PFNGLTEXIMAGE2DMULTISAMPLEPROC gl3wTexImage2DMultisample; +extern PFNGLTEXIMAGE3DPROC gl3wTexImage3D; +extern PFNGLTEXIMAGE3DMULTISAMPLEPROC gl3wTexImage3DMultisample; +extern PFNGLTEXPAGECOMMITMENTARBPROC gl3wTexPageCommitmentARB; +extern PFNGLTEXPARAMETERIIVPROC gl3wTexParameterIiv; +extern PFNGLTEXPARAMETERIUIVPROC gl3wTexParameterIuiv; +extern PFNGLTEXPARAMETERFPROC gl3wTexParameterf; +extern PFNGLTEXPARAMETERFVPROC gl3wTexParameterfv; +extern PFNGLTEXPARAMETERIPROC gl3wTexParameteri; +extern PFNGLTEXPARAMETERIVPROC gl3wTexParameteriv; +extern PFNGLTEXSTORAGE1DPROC gl3wTexStorage1D; +extern PFNGLTEXSTORAGE2DPROC gl3wTexStorage2D; +extern PFNGLTEXSTORAGE2DMULTISAMPLEPROC gl3wTexStorage2DMultisample; +extern PFNGLTEXSTORAGE3DPROC gl3wTexStorage3D; +extern PFNGLTEXSTORAGE3DMULTISAMPLEPROC gl3wTexStorage3DMultisample; +extern PFNGLTEXSUBIMAGE1DPROC gl3wTexSubImage1D; +extern PFNGLTEXSUBIMAGE2DPROC gl3wTexSubImage2D; +extern PFNGLTEXSUBIMAGE3DPROC gl3wTexSubImage3D; +extern PFNGLTEXTUREBARRIERPROC gl3wTextureBarrier; +extern PFNGLTEXTUREBUFFERPROC gl3wTextureBuffer; +extern PFNGLTEXTUREBUFFERRANGEPROC gl3wTextureBufferRange; +extern PFNGLTEXTUREPARAMETERIIVPROC gl3wTextureParameterIiv; +extern PFNGLTEXTUREPARAMETERIUIVPROC gl3wTextureParameterIuiv; +extern PFNGLTEXTUREPARAMETERFPROC gl3wTextureParameterf; +extern PFNGLTEXTUREPARAMETERFVPROC gl3wTextureParameterfv; +extern PFNGLTEXTUREPARAMETERIPROC gl3wTextureParameteri; +extern PFNGLTEXTUREPARAMETERIVPROC gl3wTextureParameteriv; +extern PFNGLTEXTURESTORAGE1DPROC gl3wTextureStorage1D; +extern PFNGLTEXTURESTORAGE2DPROC gl3wTextureStorage2D; +extern PFNGLTEXTURESTORAGE2DMULTISAMPLEPROC gl3wTextureStorage2DMultisample; +extern PFNGLTEXTURESTORAGE3DPROC gl3wTextureStorage3D; +extern PFNGLTEXTURESTORAGE3DMULTISAMPLEPROC gl3wTextureStorage3DMultisample; +extern PFNGLTEXTURESUBIMAGE1DPROC gl3wTextureSubImage1D; +extern PFNGLTEXTURESUBIMAGE2DPROC gl3wTextureSubImage2D; +extern PFNGLTEXTURESUBIMAGE3DPROC gl3wTextureSubImage3D; +extern PFNGLTEXTUREVIEWPROC gl3wTextureView; +extern PFNGLTRANSFORMFEEDBACKBUFFERBASEPROC gl3wTransformFeedbackBufferBase; +extern PFNGLTRANSFORMFEEDBACKBUFFERRANGEPROC gl3wTransformFeedbackBufferRange; +extern PFNGLTRANSFORMFEEDBACKVARYINGSPROC gl3wTransformFeedbackVaryings; +extern PFNGLUNIFORM1DPROC gl3wUniform1d; +extern PFNGLUNIFORM1DVPROC gl3wUniform1dv; +extern PFNGLUNIFORM1FPROC gl3wUniform1f; +extern PFNGLUNIFORM1FVPROC gl3wUniform1fv; +extern PFNGLUNIFORM1IPROC gl3wUniform1i; +extern PFNGLUNIFORM1IVPROC gl3wUniform1iv; +extern PFNGLUNIFORM1UIPROC gl3wUniform1ui; +extern PFNGLUNIFORM1UIVPROC gl3wUniform1uiv; +extern PFNGLUNIFORM2DPROC gl3wUniform2d; +extern PFNGLUNIFORM2DVPROC gl3wUniform2dv; +extern PFNGLUNIFORM2FPROC gl3wUniform2f; +extern PFNGLUNIFORM2FVPROC gl3wUniform2fv; +extern PFNGLUNIFORM2IPROC gl3wUniform2i; +extern PFNGLUNIFORM2IVPROC gl3wUniform2iv; +extern PFNGLUNIFORM2UIPROC gl3wUniform2ui; +extern PFNGLUNIFORM2UIVPROC gl3wUniform2uiv; +extern PFNGLUNIFORM3DPROC gl3wUniform3d; +extern PFNGLUNIFORM3DVPROC gl3wUniform3dv; +extern PFNGLUNIFORM3FPROC gl3wUniform3f; +extern PFNGLUNIFORM3FVPROC gl3wUniform3fv; +extern PFNGLUNIFORM3IPROC gl3wUniform3i; +extern PFNGLUNIFORM3IVPROC gl3wUniform3iv; +extern PFNGLUNIFORM3UIPROC gl3wUniform3ui; +extern PFNGLUNIFORM3UIVPROC gl3wUniform3uiv; +extern PFNGLUNIFORM4DPROC gl3wUniform4d; +extern PFNGLUNIFORM4DVPROC gl3wUniform4dv; +extern PFNGLUNIFORM4FPROC gl3wUniform4f; +extern PFNGLUNIFORM4FVPROC gl3wUniform4fv; +extern PFNGLUNIFORM4IPROC gl3wUniform4i; +extern PFNGLUNIFORM4IVPROC gl3wUniform4iv; +extern PFNGLUNIFORM4UIPROC gl3wUniform4ui; +extern PFNGLUNIFORM4UIVPROC gl3wUniform4uiv; +extern PFNGLUNIFORMBLOCKBINDINGPROC gl3wUniformBlockBinding; +extern PFNGLUNIFORMHANDLEUI64ARBPROC gl3wUniformHandleui64ARB; +extern PFNGLUNIFORMHANDLEUI64VARBPROC gl3wUniformHandleui64vARB; +extern PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX2DVPROC gl3wUniformMatrix2dv; +extern PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX2FVPROC gl3wUniformMatrix2fv; +extern PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX2X3DVPROC gl3wUniformMatrix2x3dv; +extern PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX2X3FVPROC gl3wUniformMatrix2x3fv; +extern PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX2X4DVPROC gl3wUniformMatrix2x4dv; +extern PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX2X4FVPROC gl3wUniformMatrix2x4fv; +extern PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX3DVPROC gl3wUniformMatrix3dv; +extern PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX3FVPROC gl3wUniformMatrix3fv; +extern PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX3X2DVPROC gl3wUniformMatrix3x2dv; +extern PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX3X2FVPROC gl3wUniformMatrix3x2fv; +extern PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX3X4DVPROC gl3wUniformMatrix3x4dv; +extern PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX3X4FVPROC gl3wUniformMatrix3x4fv; +extern PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX4DVPROC gl3wUniformMatrix4dv; +extern PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX4FVPROC gl3wUniformMatrix4fv; +extern PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX4X2DVPROC gl3wUniformMatrix4x2dv; +extern PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX4X2FVPROC gl3wUniformMatrix4x2fv; +extern PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX4X3DVPROC gl3wUniformMatrix4x3dv; +extern PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX4X3FVPROC gl3wUniformMatrix4x3fv; +extern PFNGLUNIFORMSUBROUTINESUIVPROC gl3wUniformSubroutinesuiv; +extern PFNGLUNMAPBUFFERPROC gl3wUnmapBuffer; +extern PFNGLUNMAPNAMEDBUFFERPROC gl3wUnmapNamedBuffer; +extern PFNGLUSEPROGRAMPROC gl3wUseProgram; +extern PFNGLUSEPROGRAMSTAGESPROC gl3wUseProgramStages; +extern PFNGLVALIDATEPROGRAMPROC gl3wValidateProgram; +extern PFNGLVALIDATEPROGRAMPIPELINEPROC gl3wValidateProgramPipeline; +extern PFNGLVERTEXARRAYATTRIBBINDINGPROC gl3wVertexArrayAttribBinding; +extern PFNGLVERTEXARRAYATTRIBFORMATPROC gl3wVertexArrayAttribFormat; +extern PFNGLVERTEXARRAYATTRIBIFORMATPROC gl3wVertexArrayAttribIFormat; +extern PFNGLVERTEXARRAYATTRIBLFORMATPROC gl3wVertexArrayAttribLFormat; +extern PFNGLVERTEXARRAYBINDINGDIVISORPROC gl3wVertexArrayBindingDivisor; +extern PFNGLVERTEXARRAYELEMENTBUFFERPROC gl3wVertexArrayElementBuffer; +extern PFNGLVERTEXARRAYVERTEXBUFFERPROC gl3wVertexArrayVertexBuffer; +extern PFNGLVERTEXARRAYVERTEXBUFFERSPROC gl3wVertexArrayVertexBuffers; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB1DPROC gl3wVertexAttrib1d; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB1DVPROC gl3wVertexAttrib1dv; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB1FPROC gl3wVertexAttrib1f; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB1FVPROC gl3wVertexAttrib1fv; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB1SPROC gl3wVertexAttrib1s; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB1SVPROC gl3wVertexAttrib1sv; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB2DPROC gl3wVertexAttrib2d; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB2DVPROC gl3wVertexAttrib2dv; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB2FPROC gl3wVertexAttrib2f; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB2FVPROC gl3wVertexAttrib2fv; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB2SPROC gl3wVertexAttrib2s; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB2SVPROC gl3wVertexAttrib2sv; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB3DPROC gl3wVertexAttrib3d; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB3DVPROC gl3wVertexAttrib3dv; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB3FPROC gl3wVertexAttrib3f; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB3FVPROC gl3wVertexAttrib3fv; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB3SPROC gl3wVertexAttrib3s; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB3SVPROC gl3wVertexAttrib3sv; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4NBVPROC gl3wVertexAttrib4Nbv; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4NIVPROC gl3wVertexAttrib4Niv; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4NSVPROC gl3wVertexAttrib4Nsv; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4NUBPROC gl3wVertexAttrib4Nub; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4NUBVPROC gl3wVertexAttrib4Nubv; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4NUIVPROC gl3wVertexAttrib4Nuiv; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4NUSVPROC gl3wVertexAttrib4Nusv; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4BVPROC gl3wVertexAttrib4bv; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4DPROC gl3wVertexAttrib4d; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4DVPROC gl3wVertexAttrib4dv; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4FPROC gl3wVertexAttrib4f; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4FVPROC gl3wVertexAttrib4fv; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4IVPROC gl3wVertexAttrib4iv; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4SPROC gl3wVertexAttrib4s; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4SVPROC gl3wVertexAttrib4sv; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4UBVPROC gl3wVertexAttrib4ubv; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4UIVPROC gl3wVertexAttrib4uiv; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4USVPROC gl3wVertexAttrib4usv; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBBINDINGPROC gl3wVertexAttribBinding; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBDIVISORPROC gl3wVertexAttribDivisor; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBFORMATPROC gl3wVertexAttribFormat; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI1IPROC gl3wVertexAttribI1i; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI1IVPROC gl3wVertexAttribI1iv; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI1UIPROC gl3wVertexAttribI1ui; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI1UIVPROC gl3wVertexAttribI1uiv; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI2IPROC gl3wVertexAttribI2i; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI2IVPROC gl3wVertexAttribI2iv; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI2UIPROC gl3wVertexAttribI2ui; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI2UIVPROC gl3wVertexAttribI2uiv; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI3IPROC gl3wVertexAttribI3i; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI3IVPROC gl3wVertexAttribI3iv; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI3UIPROC gl3wVertexAttribI3ui; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI3UIVPROC gl3wVertexAttribI3uiv; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI4BVPROC gl3wVertexAttribI4bv; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI4IPROC gl3wVertexAttribI4i; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI4IVPROC gl3wVertexAttribI4iv; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI4SVPROC gl3wVertexAttribI4sv; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI4UBVPROC gl3wVertexAttribI4ubv; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI4UIPROC gl3wVertexAttribI4ui; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI4UIVPROC gl3wVertexAttribI4uiv; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI4USVPROC gl3wVertexAttribI4usv; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBIFORMATPROC gl3wVertexAttribIFormat; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBIPOINTERPROC gl3wVertexAttribIPointer; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBL1DPROC gl3wVertexAttribL1d; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBL1DVPROC gl3wVertexAttribL1dv; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBL1UI64ARBPROC gl3wVertexAttribL1ui64ARB; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBL1UI64VARBPROC gl3wVertexAttribL1ui64vARB; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBL2DPROC gl3wVertexAttribL2d; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBL2DVPROC gl3wVertexAttribL2dv; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBL3DPROC gl3wVertexAttribL3d; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBL3DVPROC gl3wVertexAttribL3dv; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBL4DPROC gl3wVertexAttribL4d; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBL4DVPROC gl3wVertexAttribL4dv; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBLFORMATPROC gl3wVertexAttribLFormat; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBLPOINTERPROC gl3wVertexAttribLPointer; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBP1UIPROC gl3wVertexAttribP1ui; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBP1UIVPROC gl3wVertexAttribP1uiv; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBP2UIPROC gl3wVertexAttribP2ui; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBP2UIVPROC gl3wVertexAttribP2uiv; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBP3UIPROC gl3wVertexAttribP3ui; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBP3UIVPROC gl3wVertexAttribP3uiv; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBP4UIPROC gl3wVertexAttribP4ui; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBP4UIVPROC gl3wVertexAttribP4uiv; +extern PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBPOINTERPROC gl3wVertexAttribPointer; +extern PFNGLVERTEXBINDINGDIVISORPROC gl3wVertexBindingDivisor; +extern PFNGLVIEWPORTPROC gl3wViewport; +extern PFNGLVIEWPORTARRAYVPROC gl3wViewportArrayv; +extern PFNGLVIEWPORTINDEXEDFPROC gl3wViewportIndexedf; +extern PFNGLVIEWPORTINDEXEDFVPROC gl3wViewportIndexedfv; +extern PFNGLWAITSYNCPROC gl3wWaitSync; + +#define glActiveShaderProgram gl3wActiveShaderProgram +#define glActiveTexture gl3wActiveTexture +#define glAttachShader gl3wAttachShader +#define glBeginConditionalRender gl3wBeginConditionalRender +#define glBeginQuery gl3wBeginQuery +#define glBeginQueryIndexed gl3wBeginQueryIndexed +#define glBeginTransformFeedback gl3wBeginTransformFeedback +#define glBindAttribLocation gl3wBindAttribLocation +#define glBindBuffer gl3wBindBuffer +#define glBindBufferBase gl3wBindBufferBase +#define glBindBufferRange gl3wBindBufferRange +#define glBindBuffersBase gl3wBindBuffersBase +#define glBindBuffersRange gl3wBindBuffersRange +#define glBindFragDataLocation gl3wBindFragDataLocation +#define glBindFragDataLocationIndexed gl3wBindFragDataLocationIndexed +#define glBindFramebuffer gl3wBindFramebuffer +#define glBindImageTexture gl3wBindImageTexture +#define glBindImageTextures gl3wBindImageTextures +#define glBindProgramPipeline gl3wBindProgramPipeline +#define glBindRenderbuffer gl3wBindRenderbuffer +#define glBindSampler gl3wBindSampler +#define glBindSamplers gl3wBindSamplers +#define glBindTexture gl3wBindTexture +#define glBindTextureUnit gl3wBindTextureUnit +#define glBindTextures gl3wBindTextures +#define glBindTransformFeedback gl3wBindTransformFeedback +#define glBindVertexArray gl3wBindVertexArray +#define glBindVertexBuffer gl3wBindVertexBuffer +#define glBindVertexBuffers gl3wBindVertexBuffers +#define glBlendColor gl3wBlendColor +#define glBlendEquation gl3wBlendEquation +#define glBlendEquationSeparate gl3wBlendEquationSeparate +#define glBlendEquationSeparatei gl3wBlendEquationSeparatei +#define glBlendEquationSeparateiARB gl3wBlendEquationSeparateiARB +#define glBlendEquationi gl3wBlendEquationi +#define glBlendEquationiARB gl3wBlendEquationiARB +#define glBlendFunc gl3wBlendFunc +#define glBlendFuncSeparate gl3wBlendFuncSeparate +#define glBlendFuncSeparatei gl3wBlendFuncSeparatei +#define glBlendFuncSeparateiARB gl3wBlendFuncSeparateiARB +#define glBlendFunci gl3wBlendFunci +#define glBlendFunciARB gl3wBlendFunciARB +#define glBlitFramebuffer gl3wBlitFramebuffer +#define glBlitNamedFramebuffer gl3wBlitNamedFramebuffer +#define glBufferData gl3wBufferData +#define glBufferPageCommitmentARB gl3wBufferPageCommitmentARB +#define glBufferStorage gl3wBufferStorage +#define glBufferSubData gl3wBufferSubData +#define glCheckFramebufferStatus gl3wCheckFramebufferStatus +#define glCheckNamedFramebufferStatus gl3wCheckNamedFramebufferStatus +#define glClampColor gl3wClampColor +#define glClear gl3wClear +#define glClearBufferData gl3wClearBufferData +#define glClearBufferSubData gl3wClearBufferSubData +#define glClearBufferfi gl3wClearBufferfi +#define glClearBufferfv gl3wClearBufferfv +#define glClearBufferiv gl3wClearBufferiv +#define glClearBufferuiv gl3wClearBufferuiv +#define glClearColor gl3wClearColor +#define glClearDepth gl3wClearDepth +#define glClearDepthf gl3wClearDepthf +#define glClearNamedBufferData gl3wClearNamedBufferData +#define glClearNamedBufferSubData gl3wClearNamedBufferSubData +#define glClearNamedFramebufferfi gl3wClearNamedFramebufferfi +#define glClearNamedFramebufferfv gl3wClearNamedFramebufferfv +#define glClearNamedFramebufferiv gl3wClearNamedFramebufferiv +#define glClearNamedFramebufferuiv gl3wClearNamedFramebufferuiv +#define glClearStencil gl3wClearStencil +#define glClearTexImage gl3wClearTexImage +#define glClearTexSubImage gl3wClearTexSubImage +#define glClientWaitSync gl3wClientWaitSync +#define glClipControl gl3wClipControl +#define glColorMask gl3wColorMask +#define glColorMaski gl3wColorMaski +#define glCompileShader gl3wCompileShader +#define glCompileShaderIncludeARB gl3wCompileShaderIncludeARB +#define glCompressedTexImage1D gl3wCompressedTexImage1D +#define glCompressedTexImage2D gl3wCompressedTexImage2D +#define glCompressedTexImage3D gl3wCompressedTexImage3D +#define glCompressedTexSubImage1D gl3wCompressedTexSubImage1D +#define glCompressedTexSubImage2D gl3wCompressedTexSubImage2D +#define glCompressedTexSubImage3D gl3wCompressedTexSubImage3D +#define glCompressedTextureSubImage1D gl3wCompressedTextureSubImage1D +#define glCompressedTextureSubImage2D gl3wCompressedTextureSubImage2D +#define glCompressedTextureSubImage3D gl3wCompressedTextureSubImage3D +#define glCopyBufferSubData gl3wCopyBufferSubData +#define glCopyImageSubData gl3wCopyImageSubData +#define glCopyNamedBufferSubData gl3wCopyNamedBufferSubData +#define glCopyTexImage1D gl3wCopyTexImage1D +#define glCopyTexImage2D gl3wCopyTexImage2D +#define glCopyTexSubImage1D gl3wCopyTexSubImage1D +#define glCopyTexSubImage2D gl3wCopyTexSubImage2D +#define glCopyTexSubImage3D gl3wCopyTexSubImage3D +#define glCopyTextureSubImage1D gl3wCopyTextureSubImage1D +#define glCopyTextureSubImage2D gl3wCopyTextureSubImage2D +#define glCopyTextureSubImage3D gl3wCopyTextureSubImage3D +#define glCreateBuffers gl3wCreateBuffers +#define glCreateFramebuffers gl3wCreateFramebuffers +#define glCreateProgram gl3wCreateProgram +#define glCreateProgramPipelines gl3wCreateProgramPipelines +#define glCreateQueries gl3wCreateQueries +#define glCreateRenderbuffers gl3wCreateRenderbuffers +#define glCreateSamplers gl3wCreateSamplers +#define glCreateShader gl3wCreateShader +#define glCreateShaderProgramv gl3wCreateShaderProgramv +#define glCreateSyncFromCLeventARB gl3wCreateSyncFromCLeventARB +#define glCreateTextures gl3wCreateTextures +#define glCreateTransformFeedbacks gl3wCreateTransformFeedbacks +#define glCreateVertexArrays gl3wCreateVertexArrays +#define glCullFace gl3wCullFace +#define glDebugMessageCallback gl3wDebugMessageCallback +#define glDebugMessageCallbackARB gl3wDebugMessageCallbackARB +#define glDebugMessageControl gl3wDebugMessageControl +#define glDebugMessageControlARB gl3wDebugMessageControlARB +#define glDebugMessageInsert gl3wDebugMessageInsert +#define glDebugMessageInsertARB gl3wDebugMessageInsertARB +#define glDeleteBuffers gl3wDeleteBuffers +#define glDeleteFramebuffers gl3wDeleteFramebuffers +#define glDeleteNamedStringARB gl3wDeleteNamedStringARB +#define glDeleteProgram gl3wDeleteProgram +#define glDeleteProgramPipelines gl3wDeleteProgramPipelines +#define glDeleteQueries gl3wDeleteQueries +#define glDeleteRenderbuffers gl3wDeleteRenderbuffers +#define glDeleteSamplers gl3wDeleteSamplers +#define glDeleteShader gl3wDeleteShader +#define glDeleteSync gl3wDeleteSync +#define glDeleteTextures gl3wDeleteTextures +#define glDeleteTransformFeedbacks gl3wDeleteTransformFeedbacks +#define glDeleteVertexArrays gl3wDeleteVertexArrays +#define glDepthFunc gl3wDepthFunc +#define glDepthMask gl3wDepthMask +#define glDepthRange gl3wDepthRange +#define glDepthRangeArrayv gl3wDepthRangeArrayv +#define glDepthRangeIndexed gl3wDepthRangeIndexed +#define glDepthRangef gl3wDepthRangef +#define glDetachShader gl3wDetachShader +#define glDisable gl3wDisable +#define glDisableVertexArrayAttrib gl3wDisableVertexArrayAttrib +#define glDisableVertexAttribArray gl3wDisableVertexAttribArray +#define glDisablei gl3wDisablei +#define glDispatchCompute gl3wDispatchCompute +#define glDispatchComputeGroupSizeARB gl3wDispatchComputeGroupSizeARB +#define glDispatchComputeIndirect gl3wDispatchComputeIndirect +#define glDrawArrays gl3wDrawArrays +#define glDrawArraysIndirect gl3wDrawArraysIndirect +#define glDrawArraysInstanced gl3wDrawArraysInstanced +#define glDrawArraysInstancedBaseInstance gl3wDrawArraysInstancedBaseInstance +#define glDrawBuffer gl3wDrawBuffer +#define glDrawBuffers gl3wDrawBuffers +#define glDrawElements gl3wDrawElements +#define glDrawElementsBaseVertex gl3wDrawElementsBaseVertex +#define glDrawElementsIndirect gl3wDrawElementsIndirect +#define glDrawElementsInstanced gl3wDrawElementsInstanced +#define glDrawElementsInstancedBaseInstance gl3wDrawElementsInstancedBaseInstance +#define glDrawElementsInstancedBaseVertex gl3wDrawElementsInstancedBaseVertex +#define glDrawElementsInstancedBaseVertexBaseInstance gl3wDrawElementsInstancedBaseVertexBaseInstance +#define glDrawRangeElements gl3wDrawRangeElements +#define glDrawRangeElementsBaseVertex gl3wDrawRangeElementsBaseVertex +#define glDrawTransformFeedback gl3wDrawTransformFeedback +#define glDrawTransformFeedbackInstanced gl3wDrawTransformFeedbackInstanced +#define glDrawTransformFeedbackStream gl3wDrawTransformFeedbackStream +#define glDrawTransformFeedbackStreamInstanced gl3wDrawTransformFeedbackStreamInstanced +#define glEnable gl3wEnable +#define glEnableVertexArrayAttrib gl3wEnableVertexArrayAttrib +#define glEnableVertexAttribArray gl3wEnableVertexAttribArray +#define glEnablei gl3wEnablei +#define glEndConditionalRender gl3wEndConditionalRender +#define glEndQuery gl3wEndQuery +#define glEndQueryIndexed gl3wEndQueryIndexed +#define glEndTransformFeedback gl3wEndTransformFeedback +#define glFenceSync gl3wFenceSync +#define glFinish gl3wFinish +#define glFlush gl3wFlush +#define glFlushMappedBufferRange gl3wFlushMappedBufferRange +#define glFlushMappedNamedBufferRange gl3wFlushMappedNamedBufferRange +#define glFramebufferParameteri gl3wFramebufferParameteri +#define glFramebufferRenderbuffer gl3wFramebufferRenderbuffer +#define glFramebufferTexture gl3wFramebufferTexture +#define glFramebufferTexture1D gl3wFramebufferTexture1D +#define glFramebufferTexture2D gl3wFramebufferTexture2D +#define glFramebufferTexture3D gl3wFramebufferTexture3D +#define glFramebufferTextureLayer gl3wFramebufferTextureLayer +#define glFrontFace gl3wFrontFace +#define glGenBuffers gl3wGenBuffers +#define glGenFramebuffers gl3wGenFramebuffers +#define glGenProgramPipelines gl3wGenProgramPipelines +#define glGenQueries gl3wGenQueries +#define glGenRenderbuffers gl3wGenRenderbuffers +#define glGenSamplers gl3wGenSamplers +#define glGenTextures gl3wGenTextures +#define glGenTransformFeedbacks gl3wGenTransformFeedbacks +#define glGenVertexArrays gl3wGenVertexArrays +#define glGenerateMipmap gl3wGenerateMipmap +#define glGenerateTextureMipmap gl3wGenerateTextureMipmap +#define glGetActiveAtomicCounterBufferiv gl3wGetActiveAtomicCounterBufferiv +#define glGetActiveAttrib gl3wGetActiveAttrib +#define glGetActiveSubroutineName gl3wGetActiveSubroutineName +#define glGetActiveSubroutineUniformName gl3wGetActiveSubroutineUniformName +#define glGetActiveSubroutineUniformiv gl3wGetActiveSubroutineUniformiv +#define glGetActiveUniform gl3wGetActiveUniform +#define glGetActiveUniformBlockName gl3wGetActiveUniformBlockName +#define glGetActiveUniformBlockiv gl3wGetActiveUniformBlockiv +#define glGetActiveUniformName gl3wGetActiveUniformName +#define glGetActiveUniformsiv gl3wGetActiveUniformsiv +#define glGetAttachedShaders gl3wGetAttachedShaders +#define glGetAttribLocation gl3wGetAttribLocation +#define glGetBooleani_v gl3wGetBooleani_v +#define glGetBooleanv gl3wGetBooleanv +#define glGetBufferParameteri64v gl3wGetBufferParameteri64v +#define glGetBufferParameteriv gl3wGetBufferParameteriv +#define glGetBufferPointerv gl3wGetBufferPointerv +#define glGetBufferSubData gl3wGetBufferSubData +#define glGetCompressedTexImage gl3wGetCompressedTexImage +#define glGetCompressedTextureImage gl3wGetCompressedTextureImage +#define glGetCompressedTextureSubImage gl3wGetCompressedTextureSubImage +#define glGetDebugMessageLog gl3wGetDebugMessageLog +#define glGetDebugMessageLogARB gl3wGetDebugMessageLogARB +#define glGetDoublei_v gl3wGetDoublei_v +#define glGetDoublev gl3wGetDoublev +#define glGetError gl3wGetError +#define glGetFloati_v gl3wGetFloati_v +#define glGetFloatv gl3wGetFloatv +#define glGetFragDataIndex gl3wGetFragDataIndex +#define glGetFragDataLocation gl3wGetFragDataLocation +#define glGetFramebufferAttachmentParameteriv gl3wGetFramebufferAttachmentParameteriv +#define glGetFramebufferParameteriv gl3wGetFramebufferParameteriv +#define glGetGraphicsResetStatus gl3wGetGraphicsResetStatus +#define glGetGraphicsResetStatusARB gl3wGetGraphicsResetStatusARB +#define glGetImageHandleARB gl3wGetImageHandleARB +#define glGetInteger64i_v gl3wGetInteger64i_v +#define glGetInteger64v gl3wGetInteger64v +#define glGetIntegeri_v gl3wGetIntegeri_v +#define glGetIntegerv gl3wGetIntegerv +#define glGetInternalformati64v gl3wGetInternalformati64v +#define glGetInternalformativ gl3wGetInternalformativ +#define glGetMultisamplefv gl3wGetMultisamplefv +#define glGetNamedBufferParameteri64v gl3wGetNamedBufferParameteri64v +#define glGetNamedBufferParameteriv gl3wGetNamedBufferParameteriv +#define glGetNamedBufferPointerv gl3wGetNamedBufferPointerv +#define glGetNamedBufferSubData gl3wGetNamedBufferSubData +#define glGetNamedFramebufferAttachmentParameteriv gl3wGetNamedFramebufferAttachmentParameteriv +#define glGetNamedFramebufferParameteriv gl3wGetNamedFramebufferParameteriv +#define glGetNamedRenderbufferParameteriv gl3wGetNamedRenderbufferParameteriv +#define glGetNamedStringARB gl3wGetNamedStringARB +#define glGetNamedStringivARB gl3wGetNamedStringivARB +#define glGetObjectLabel gl3wGetObjectLabel +#define glGetObjectPtrLabel gl3wGetObjectPtrLabel +#define glGetPointerv gl3wGetPointerv +#define glGetProgramBinary gl3wGetProgramBinary +#define glGetProgramInfoLog gl3wGetProgramInfoLog +#define glGetProgramInterfaceiv gl3wGetProgramInterfaceiv +#define glGetProgramPipelineInfoLog gl3wGetProgramPipelineInfoLog +#define glGetProgramPipelineiv gl3wGetProgramPipelineiv +#define glGetProgramResourceIndex gl3wGetProgramResourceIndex +#define glGetProgramResourceLocation gl3wGetProgramResourceLocation +#define glGetProgramResourceLocationIndex gl3wGetProgramResourceLocationIndex +#define glGetProgramResourceName gl3wGetProgramResourceName +#define glGetProgramResourceiv gl3wGetProgramResourceiv +#define glGetProgramStageiv gl3wGetProgramStageiv +#define glGetProgramiv gl3wGetProgramiv +#define glGetQueryBufferObjecti64v gl3wGetQueryBufferObjecti64v +#define glGetQueryBufferObjectiv gl3wGetQueryBufferObjectiv +#define glGetQueryBufferObjectui64v gl3wGetQueryBufferObjectui64v +#define glGetQueryBufferObjectuiv gl3wGetQueryBufferObjectuiv +#define glGetQueryIndexediv gl3wGetQueryIndexediv +#define glGetQueryObjecti64v gl3wGetQueryObjecti64v +#define glGetQueryObjectiv gl3wGetQueryObjectiv +#define glGetQueryObjectui64v gl3wGetQueryObjectui64v +#define glGetQueryObjectuiv gl3wGetQueryObjectuiv +#define glGetQueryiv gl3wGetQueryiv +#define glGetRenderbufferParameteriv gl3wGetRenderbufferParameteriv +#define glGetSamplerParameterIiv gl3wGetSamplerParameterIiv +#define glGetSamplerParameterIuiv gl3wGetSamplerParameterIuiv +#define glGetSamplerParameterfv gl3wGetSamplerParameterfv +#define glGetSamplerParameteriv gl3wGetSamplerParameteriv +#define glGetShaderInfoLog gl3wGetShaderInfoLog +#define glGetShaderPrecisionFormat gl3wGetShaderPrecisionFormat +#define glGetShaderSource gl3wGetShaderSource +#define glGetShaderiv gl3wGetShaderiv +#define glGetString gl3wGetString +#define glGetStringi gl3wGetStringi +#define glGetSubroutineIndex gl3wGetSubroutineIndex +#define glGetSubroutineUniformLocation gl3wGetSubroutineUniformLocation +#define glGetSynciv gl3wGetSynciv +#define glGetTexImage gl3wGetTexImage +#define glGetTexLevelParameterfv gl3wGetTexLevelParameterfv +#define glGetTexLevelParameteriv gl3wGetTexLevelParameteriv +#define glGetTexParameterIiv gl3wGetTexParameterIiv +#define glGetTexParameterIuiv gl3wGetTexParameterIuiv +#define glGetTexParameterfv gl3wGetTexParameterfv +#define glGetTexParameteriv gl3wGetTexParameteriv +#define glGetTextureHandleARB gl3wGetTextureHandleARB +#define glGetTextureImage gl3wGetTextureImage +#define glGetTextureLevelParameterfv gl3wGetTextureLevelParameterfv +#define glGetTextureLevelParameteriv gl3wGetTextureLevelParameteriv +#define glGetTextureParameterIiv gl3wGetTextureParameterIiv +#define glGetTextureParameterIuiv gl3wGetTextureParameterIuiv +#define glGetTextureParameterfv gl3wGetTextureParameterfv +#define glGetTextureParameteriv gl3wGetTextureParameteriv +#define glGetTextureSamplerHandleARB gl3wGetTextureSamplerHandleARB +#define glGetTextureSubImage gl3wGetTextureSubImage +#define glGetTransformFeedbackVarying gl3wGetTransformFeedbackVarying +#define glGetTransformFeedbacki64_v gl3wGetTransformFeedbacki64_v +#define glGetTransformFeedbacki_v gl3wGetTransformFeedbacki_v +#define glGetTransformFeedbackiv gl3wGetTransformFeedbackiv +#define glGetUniformBlockIndex gl3wGetUniformBlockIndex +#define glGetUniformIndices gl3wGetUniformIndices +#define glGetUniformLocation gl3wGetUniformLocation +#define glGetUniformSubroutineuiv gl3wGetUniformSubroutineuiv +#define glGetUniformdv gl3wGetUniformdv +#define glGetUniformfv gl3wGetUniformfv +#define glGetUniformiv gl3wGetUniformiv +#define glGetUniformuiv gl3wGetUniformuiv +#define glGetVertexArrayIndexed64iv gl3wGetVertexArrayIndexed64iv +#define glGetVertexArrayIndexediv gl3wGetVertexArrayIndexediv +#define glGetVertexArrayiv gl3wGetVertexArrayiv +#define glGetVertexAttribIiv gl3wGetVertexAttribIiv +#define glGetVertexAttribIuiv gl3wGetVertexAttribIuiv +#define glGetVertexAttribLdv gl3wGetVertexAttribLdv +#define glGetVertexAttribLui64vARB gl3wGetVertexAttribLui64vARB +#define glGetVertexAttribPointerv gl3wGetVertexAttribPointerv +#define glGetVertexAttribdv gl3wGetVertexAttribdv +#define glGetVertexAttribfv gl3wGetVertexAttribfv +#define glGetVertexAttribiv gl3wGetVertexAttribiv +#define glGetnCompressedTexImage gl3wGetnCompressedTexImage +#define glGetnCompressedTexImageARB gl3wGetnCompressedTexImageARB +#define glGetnTexImage gl3wGetnTexImage +#define glGetnTexImageARB gl3wGetnTexImageARB +#define glGetnUniformdv gl3wGetnUniformdv +#define glGetnUniformdvARB gl3wGetnUniformdvARB +#define glGetnUniformfv gl3wGetnUniformfv +#define glGetnUniformfvARB gl3wGetnUniformfvARB +#define glGetnUniformiv gl3wGetnUniformiv +#define glGetnUniformivARB gl3wGetnUniformivARB +#define glGetnUniformuiv gl3wGetnUniformuiv +#define glGetnUniformuivARB gl3wGetnUniformuivARB +#define glHint gl3wHint +#define glInvalidateBufferData gl3wInvalidateBufferData +#define glInvalidateBufferSubData gl3wInvalidateBufferSubData +#define glInvalidateFramebuffer gl3wInvalidateFramebuffer +#define glInvalidateNamedFramebufferData gl3wInvalidateNamedFramebufferData +#define glInvalidateNamedFramebufferSubData gl3wInvalidateNamedFramebufferSubData +#define glInvalidateSubFramebuffer gl3wInvalidateSubFramebuffer +#define glInvalidateTexImage gl3wInvalidateTexImage +#define glInvalidateTexSubImage gl3wInvalidateTexSubImage +#define glIsBuffer gl3wIsBuffer +#define glIsEnabled gl3wIsEnabled +#define glIsEnabledi gl3wIsEnabledi +#define glIsFramebuffer gl3wIsFramebuffer +#define glIsImageHandleResidentARB gl3wIsImageHandleResidentARB +#define glIsNamedStringARB gl3wIsNamedStringARB +#define glIsProgram gl3wIsProgram +#define glIsProgramPipeline gl3wIsProgramPipeline +#define glIsQuery gl3wIsQuery +#define glIsRenderbuffer gl3wIsRenderbuffer +#define glIsSampler gl3wIsSampler +#define glIsShader gl3wIsShader +#define glIsSync gl3wIsSync +#define glIsTexture gl3wIsTexture +#define glIsTextureHandleResidentARB gl3wIsTextureHandleResidentARB +#define glIsTransformFeedback gl3wIsTransformFeedback +#define glIsVertexArray gl3wIsVertexArray +#define glLineWidth gl3wLineWidth +#define glLinkProgram gl3wLinkProgram +#define glLogicOp gl3wLogicOp +#define glMakeImageHandleNonResidentARB gl3wMakeImageHandleNonResidentARB +#define glMakeImageHandleResidentARB gl3wMakeImageHandleResidentARB +#define glMakeTextureHandleNonResidentARB gl3wMakeTextureHandleNonResidentARB +#define glMakeTextureHandleResidentARB gl3wMakeTextureHandleResidentARB +#define glMapBuffer gl3wMapBuffer +#define glMapBufferRange gl3wMapBufferRange +#define glMapNamedBuffer gl3wMapNamedBuffer +#define glMapNamedBufferRange gl3wMapNamedBufferRange +#define glMemoryBarrier gl3wMemoryBarrier +#define glMemoryBarrierByRegion gl3wMemoryBarrierByRegion +#define glMinSampleShading gl3wMinSampleShading +#define glMinSampleShadingARB gl3wMinSampleShadingARB +#define glMultiDrawArrays gl3wMultiDrawArrays +#define glMultiDrawArraysIndirect gl3wMultiDrawArraysIndirect +#define glMultiDrawArraysIndirectCountARB gl3wMultiDrawArraysIndirectCountARB +#define glMultiDrawElements gl3wMultiDrawElements +#define glMultiDrawElementsBaseVertex gl3wMultiDrawElementsBaseVertex +#define glMultiDrawElementsIndirect gl3wMultiDrawElementsIndirect +#define glMultiDrawElementsIndirectCountARB gl3wMultiDrawElementsIndirectCountARB +#define glNamedBufferData gl3wNamedBufferData +#define glNamedBufferPageCommitmentARB gl3wNamedBufferPageCommitmentARB +#define glNamedBufferPageCommitmentEXT gl3wNamedBufferPageCommitmentEXT +#define glNamedBufferStorage gl3wNamedBufferStorage +#define glNamedBufferSubData gl3wNamedBufferSubData +#define glNamedFramebufferDrawBuffer gl3wNamedFramebufferDrawBuffer +#define glNamedFramebufferDrawBuffers gl3wNamedFramebufferDrawBuffers +#define glNamedFramebufferParameteri gl3wNamedFramebufferParameteri +#define glNamedFramebufferReadBuffer gl3wNamedFramebufferReadBuffer +#define glNamedFramebufferRenderbuffer gl3wNamedFramebufferRenderbuffer +#define glNamedFramebufferTexture gl3wNamedFramebufferTexture +#define glNamedFramebufferTextureLayer gl3wNamedFramebufferTextureLayer +#define glNamedRenderbufferStorage gl3wNamedRenderbufferStorage +#define glNamedRenderbufferStorageMultisample gl3wNamedRenderbufferStorageMultisample +#define glNamedStringARB gl3wNamedStringARB +#define glObjectLabel gl3wObjectLabel +#define glObjectPtrLabel gl3wObjectPtrLabel +#define glPatchParameterfv gl3wPatchParameterfv +#define glPatchParameteri gl3wPatchParameteri +#define glPauseTransformFeedback gl3wPauseTransformFeedback +#define glPixelStoref gl3wPixelStoref +#define glPixelStorei gl3wPixelStorei +#define glPointParameterf gl3wPointParameterf +#define glPointParameterfv gl3wPointParameterfv +#define glPointParameteri gl3wPointParameteri +#define glPointParameteriv gl3wPointParameteriv +#define glPointSize gl3wPointSize +#define glPolygonMode gl3wPolygonMode +#define glPolygonOffset gl3wPolygonOffset +#define glPopDebugGroup gl3wPopDebugGroup +#define glPrimitiveRestartIndex gl3wPrimitiveRestartIndex +#define glProgramBinary gl3wProgramBinary +#define glProgramParameteri gl3wProgramParameteri +#define glProgramUniform1d gl3wProgramUniform1d +#define glProgramUniform1dv gl3wProgramUniform1dv +#define glProgramUniform1f gl3wProgramUniform1f +#define glProgramUniform1fv gl3wProgramUniform1fv +#define glProgramUniform1i gl3wProgramUniform1i +#define glProgramUniform1iv gl3wProgramUniform1iv +#define glProgramUniform1ui gl3wProgramUniform1ui +#define glProgramUniform1uiv gl3wProgramUniform1uiv +#define glProgramUniform2d gl3wProgramUniform2d +#define glProgramUniform2dv gl3wProgramUniform2dv +#define glProgramUniform2f gl3wProgramUniform2f +#define glProgramUniform2fv gl3wProgramUniform2fv +#define glProgramUniform2i gl3wProgramUniform2i +#define glProgramUniform2iv gl3wProgramUniform2iv +#define glProgramUniform2ui gl3wProgramUniform2ui +#define glProgramUniform2uiv gl3wProgramUniform2uiv +#define glProgramUniform3d gl3wProgramUniform3d +#define glProgramUniform3dv gl3wProgramUniform3dv +#define glProgramUniform3f gl3wProgramUniform3f +#define glProgramUniform3fv gl3wProgramUniform3fv +#define glProgramUniform3i gl3wProgramUniform3i +#define glProgramUniform3iv gl3wProgramUniform3iv +#define glProgramUniform3ui gl3wProgramUniform3ui +#define glProgramUniform3uiv gl3wProgramUniform3uiv +#define glProgramUniform4d gl3wProgramUniform4d +#define glProgramUniform4dv gl3wProgramUniform4dv +#define glProgramUniform4f gl3wProgramUniform4f +#define glProgramUniform4fv gl3wProgramUniform4fv +#define glProgramUniform4i gl3wProgramUniform4i +#define glProgramUniform4iv gl3wProgramUniform4iv +#define glProgramUniform4ui gl3wProgramUniform4ui +#define glProgramUniform4uiv gl3wProgramUniform4uiv +#define glProgramUniformHandleui64ARB gl3wProgramUniformHandleui64ARB +#define glProgramUniformHandleui64vARB gl3wProgramUniformHandleui64vARB +#define glProgramUniformMatrix2dv gl3wProgramUniformMatrix2dv +#define glProgramUniformMatrix2fv gl3wProgramUniformMatrix2fv +#define glProgramUniformMatrix2x3dv gl3wProgramUniformMatrix2x3dv +#define glProgramUniformMatrix2x3fv gl3wProgramUniformMatrix2x3fv +#define glProgramUniformMatrix2x4dv gl3wProgramUniformMatrix2x4dv +#define glProgramUniformMatrix2x4fv gl3wProgramUniformMatrix2x4fv +#define glProgramUniformMatrix3dv gl3wProgramUniformMatrix3dv +#define glProgramUniformMatrix3fv gl3wProgramUniformMatrix3fv +#define glProgramUniformMatrix3x2dv gl3wProgramUniformMatrix3x2dv +#define glProgramUniformMatrix3x2fv gl3wProgramUniformMatrix3x2fv +#define glProgramUniformMatrix3x4dv gl3wProgramUniformMatrix3x4dv +#define glProgramUniformMatrix3x4fv gl3wProgramUniformMatrix3x4fv +#define glProgramUniformMatrix4dv gl3wProgramUniformMatrix4dv +#define glProgramUniformMatrix4fv gl3wProgramUniformMatrix4fv +#define glProgramUniformMatrix4x2dv gl3wProgramUniformMatrix4x2dv +#define glProgramUniformMatrix4x2fv gl3wProgramUniformMatrix4x2fv +#define glProgramUniformMatrix4x3dv gl3wProgramUniformMatrix4x3dv +#define glProgramUniformMatrix4x3fv gl3wProgramUniformMatrix4x3fv +#define glProvokingVertex gl3wProvokingVertex +#define glPushDebugGroup gl3wPushDebugGroup +#define glQueryCounter gl3wQueryCounter +#define glReadBuffer gl3wReadBuffer +#define glReadPixels gl3wReadPixels +#define glReadnPixels gl3wReadnPixels +#define glReadnPixelsARB gl3wReadnPixelsARB +#define glReleaseShaderCompiler gl3wReleaseShaderCompiler +#define glRenderbufferStorage gl3wRenderbufferStorage +#define glRenderbufferStorageMultisample gl3wRenderbufferStorageMultisample +#define glResumeTransformFeedback gl3wResumeTransformFeedback +#define glSampleCoverage gl3wSampleCoverage +#define glSampleMaski gl3wSampleMaski +#define glSamplerParameterIiv gl3wSamplerParameterIiv +#define glSamplerParameterIuiv gl3wSamplerParameterIuiv +#define glSamplerParameterf gl3wSamplerParameterf +#define glSamplerParameterfv gl3wSamplerParameterfv +#define glSamplerParameteri gl3wSamplerParameteri +#define glSamplerParameteriv gl3wSamplerParameteriv +#define glScissor gl3wScissor +#define glScissorArrayv gl3wScissorArrayv +#define glScissorIndexed gl3wScissorIndexed +#define glScissorIndexedv gl3wScissorIndexedv +#define glShaderBinary gl3wShaderBinary +#define glShaderSource gl3wShaderSource +#define glShaderStorageBlockBinding gl3wShaderStorageBlockBinding +#define glStencilFunc gl3wStencilFunc +#define glStencilFuncSeparate gl3wStencilFuncSeparate +#define glStencilMask gl3wStencilMask +#define glStencilMaskSeparate gl3wStencilMaskSeparate +#define glStencilOp gl3wStencilOp +#define glStencilOpSeparate gl3wStencilOpSeparate +#define glTexBuffer gl3wTexBuffer +#define glTexBufferRange gl3wTexBufferRange +#define glTexImage1D gl3wTexImage1D +#define glTexImage2D gl3wTexImage2D +#define glTexImage2DMultisample gl3wTexImage2DMultisample +#define glTexImage3D gl3wTexImage3D +#define glTexImage3DMultisample gl3wTexImage3DMultisample +#define glTexPageCommitmentARB gl3wTexPageCommitmentARB +#define glTexParameterIiv gl3wTexParameterIiv +#define glTexParameterIuiv gl3wTexParameterIuiv +#define glTexParameterf gl3wTexParameterf +#define glTexParameterfv gl3wTexParameterfv +#define glTexParameteri gl3wTexParameteri +#define glTexParameteriv gl3wTexParameteriv +#define glTexStorage1D gl3wTexStorage1D +#define glTexStorage2D gl3wTexStorage2D +#define glTexStorage2DMultisample gl3wTexStorage2DMultisample +#define glTexStorage3D gl3wTexStorage3D +#define glTexStorage3DMultisample gl3wTexStorage3DMultisample +#define glTexSubImage1D gl3wTexSubImage1D +#define glTexSubImage2D gl3wTexSubImage2D +#define glTexSubImage3D gl3wTexSubImage3D +#define glTextureBarrier gl3wTextureBarrier +#define glTextureBuffer gl3wTextureBuffer +#define glTextureBufferRange gl3wTextureBufferRange +#define glTextureParameterIiv gl3wTextureParameterIiv +#define glTextureParameterIuiv gl3wTextureParameterIuiv +#define glTextureParameterf gl3wTextureParameterf +#define glTextureParameterfv gl3wTextureParameterfv +#define glTextureParameteri gl3wTextureParameteri +#define glTextureParameteriv gl3wTextureParameteriv +#define glTextureStorage1D gl3wTextureStorage1D +#define glTextureStorage2D gl3wTextureStorage2D +#define glTextureStorage2DMultisample gl3wTextureStorage2DMultisample +#define glTextureStorage3D gl3wTextureStorage3D +#define glTextureStorage3DMultisample gl3wTextureStorage3DMultisample +#define glTextureSubImage1D gl3wTextureSubImage1D +#define glTextureSubImage2D gl3wTextureSubImage2D +#define glTextureSubImage3D gl3wTextureSubImage3D +#define glTextureView gl3wTextureView +#define glTransformFeedbackBufferBase gl3wTransformFeedbackBufferBase +#define glTransformFeedbackBufferRange gl3wTransformFeedbackBufferRange +#define glTransformFeedbackVaryings gl3wTransformFeedbackVaryings +#define glUniform1d gl3wUniform1d +#define glUniform1dv gl3wUniform1dv +#define glUniform1f gl3wUniform1f +#define glUniform1fv gl3wUniform1fv +#define glUniform1i gl3wUniform1i +#define glUniform1iv gl3wUniform1iv +#define glUniform1ui gl3wUniform1ui +#define glUniform1uiv gl3wUniform1uiv +#define glUniform2d gl3wUniform2d +#define glUniform2dv gl3wUniform2dv +#define glUniform2f gl3wUniform2f +#define glUniform2fv gl3wUniform2fv +#define glUniform2i gl3wUniform2i +#define glUniform2iv gl3wUniform2iv +#define glUniform2ui gl3wUniform2ui +#define glUniform2uiv gl3wUniform2uiv +#define glUniform3d gl3wUniform3d +#define glUniform3dv gl3wUniform3dv +#define glUniform3f gl3wUniform3f +#define glUniform3fv gl3wUniform3fv +#define glUniform3i gl3wUniform3i +#define glUniform3iv gl3wUniform3iv +#define glUniform3ui gl3wUniform3ui +#define glUniform3uiv gl3wUniform3uiv +#define glUniform4d gl3wUniform4d +#define glUniform4dv gl3wUniform4dv +#define glUniform4f gl3wUniform4f +#define glUniform4fv gl3wUniform4fv +#define glUniform4i gl3wUniform4i +#define glUniform4iv gl3wUniform4iv +#define glUniform4ui gl3wUniform4ui +#define glUniform4uiv gl3wUniform4uiv +#define glUniformBlockBinding gl3wUniformBlockBinding +#define glUniformHandleui64ARB gl3wUniformHandleui64ARB +#define glUniformHandleui64vARB gl3wUniformHandleui64vARB +#define glUniformMatrix2dv gl3wUniformMatrix2dv +#define glUniformMatrix2fv gl3wUniformMatrix2fv +#define glUniformMatrix2x3dv gl3wUniformMatrix2x3dv +#define glUniformMatrix2x3fv gl3wUniformMatrix2x3fv +#define glUniformMatrix2x4dv gl3wUniformMatrix2x4dv +#define glUniformMatrix2x4fv gl3wUniformMatrix2x4fv +#define glUniformMatrix3dv gl3wUniformMatrix3dv +#define glUniformMatrix3fv gl3wUniformMatrix3fv +#define glUniformMatrix3x2dv gl3wUniformMatrix3x2dv +#define glUniformMatrix3x2fv gl3wUniformMatrix3x2fv +#define glUniformMatrix3x4dv gl3wUniformMatrix3x4dv +#define glUniformMatrix3x4fv gl3wUniformMatrix3x4fv +#define glUniformMatrix4dv gl3wUniformMatrix4dv +#define glUniformMatrix4fv gl3wUniformMatrix4fv +#define glUniformMatrix4x2dv gl3wUniformMatrix4x2dv +#define glUniformMatrix4x2fv gl3wUniformMatrix4x2fv +#define glUniformMatrix4x3dv gl3wUniformMatrix4x3dv +#define glUniformMatrix4x3fv gl3wUniformMatrix4x3fv +#define glUniformSubroutinesuiv gl3wUniformSubroutinesuiv +#define glUnmapBuffer gl3wUnmapBuffer +#define glUnmapNamedBuffer gl3wUnmapNamedBuffer +#define glUseProgram gl3wUseProgram +#define glUseProgramStages gl3wUseProgramStages +#define glValidateProgram gl3wValidateProgram +#define glValidateProgramPipeline gl3wValidateProgramPipeline +#define glVertexArrayAttribBinding gl3wVertexArrayAttribBinding +#define glVertexArrayAttribFormat gl3wVertexArrayAttribFormat +#define glVertexArrayAttribIFormat gl3wVertexArrayAttribIFormat +#define glVertexArrayAttribLFormat gl3wVertexArrayAttribLFormat +#define glVertexArrayBindingDivisor gl3wVertexArrayBindingDivisor +#define glVertexArrayElementBuffer gl3wVertexArrayElementBuffer +#define glVertexArrayVertexBuffer gl3wVertexArrayVertexBuffer +#define glVertexArrayVertexBuffers gl3wVertexArrayVertexBuffers +#define glVertexAttrib1d gl3wVertexAttrib1d +#define glVertexAttrib1dv gl3wVertexAttrib1dv +#define glVertexAttrib1f gl3wVertexAttrib1f +#define glVertexAttrib1fv gl3wVertexAttrib1fv +#define glVertexAttrib1s gl3wVertexAttrib1s +#define glVertexAttrib1sv gl3wVertexAttrib1sv +#define glVertexAttrib2d gl3wVertexAttrib2d +#define glVertexAttrib2dv gl3wVertexAttrib2dv +#define glVertexAttrib2f gl3wVertexAttrib2f +#define glVertexAttrib2fv gl3wVertexAttrib2fv +#define glVertexAttrib2s gl3wVertexAttrib2s +#define glVertexAttrib2sv gl3wVertexAttrib2sv +#define glVertexAttrib3d gl3wVertexAttrib3d +#define glVertexAttrib3dv gl3wVertexAttrib3dv +#define glVertexAttrib3f gl3wVertexAttrib3f +#define glVertexAttrib3fv gl3wVertexAttrib3fv +#define glVertexAttrib3s gl3wVertexAttrib3s +#define glVertexAttrib3sv gl3wVertexAttrib3sv +#define glVertexAttrib4Nbv gl3wVertexAttrib4Nbv +#define glVertexAttrib4Niv gl3wVertexAttrib4Niv +#define glVertexAttrib4Nsv gl3wVertexAttrib4Nsv +#define glVertexAttrib4Nub gl3wVertexAttrib4Nub +#define glVertexAttrib4Nubv gl3wVertexAttrib4Nubv +#define glVertexAttrib4Nuiv gl3wVertexAttrib4Nuiv +#define glVertexAttrib4Nusv gl3wVertexAttrib4Nusv +#define glVertexAttrib4bv gl3wVertexAttrib4bv +#define glVertexAttrib4d gl3wVertexAttrib4d +#define glVertexAttrib4dv gl3wVertexAttrib4dv +#define glVertexAttrib4f gl3wVertexAttrib4f +#define glVertexAttrib4fv gl3wVertexAttrib4fv +#define glVertexAttrib4iv gl3wVertexAttrib4iv +#define glVertexAttrib4s gl3wVertexAttrib4s +#define glVertexAttrib4sv gl3wVertexAttrib4sv +#define glVertexAttrib4ubv gl3wVertexAttrib4ubv +#define glVertexAttrib4uiv gl3wVertexAttrib4uiv +#define glVertexAttrib4usv gl3wVertexAttrib4usv +#define glVertexAttribBinding gl3wVertexAttribBinding +#define glVertexAttribDivisor gl3wVertexAttribDivisor +#define glVertexAttribFormat gl3wVertexAttribFormat +#define glVertexAttribI1i gl3wVertexAttribI1i +#define glVertexAttribI1iv gl3wVertexAttribI1iv +#define glVertexAttribI1ui gl3wVertexAttribI1ui +#define glVertexAttribI1uiv gl3wVertexAttribI1uiv +#define glVertexAttribI2i gl3wVertexAttribI2i +#define glVertexAttribI2iv gl3wVertexAttribI2iv +#define glVertexAttribI2ui gl3wVertexAttribI2ui +#define glVertexAttribI2uiv gl3wVertexAttribI2uiv +#define glVertexAttribI3i gl3wVertexAttribI3i +#define glVertexAttribI3iv gl3wVertexAttribI3iv +#define glVertexAttribI3ui gl3wVertexAttribI3ui +#define glVertexAttribI3uiv gl3wVertexAttribI3uiv +#define glVertexAttribI4bv gl3wVertexAttribI4bv +#define glVertexAttribI4i gl3wVertexAttribI4i +#define glVertexAttribI4iv gl3wVertexAttribI4iv +#define glVertexAttribI4sv gl3wVertexAttribI4sv +#define glVertexAttribI4ubv gl3wVertexAttribI4ubv +#define glVertexAttribI4ui gl3wVertexAttribI4ui +#define glVertexAttribI4uiv gl3wVertexAttribI4uiv +#define glVertexAttribI4usv gl3wVertexAttribI4usv +#define glVertexAttribIFormat gl3wVertexAttribIFormat +#define glVertexAttribIPointer gl3wVertexAttribIPointer +#define glVertexAttribL1d gl3wVertexAttribL1d +#define glVertexAttribL1dv gl3wVertexAttribL1dv +#define glVertexAttribL1ui64ARB gl3wVertexAttribL1ui64ARB +#define glVertexAttribL1ui64vARB gl3wVertexAttribL1ui64vARB +#define glVertexAttribL2d gl3wVertexAttribL2d +#define glVertexAttribL2dv gl3wVertexAttribL2dv +#define glVertexAttribL3d gl3wVertexAttribL3d +#define glVertexAttribL3dv gl3wVertexAttribL3dv +#define glVertexAttribL4d gl3wVertexAttribL4d +#define glVertexAttribL4dv gl3wVertexAttribL4dv +#define glVertexAttribLFormat gl3wVertexAttribLFormat +#define glVertexAttribLPointer gl3wVertexAttribLPointer +#define glVertexAttribP1ui gl3wVertexAttribP1ui +#define glVertexAttribP1uiv gl3wVertexAttribP1uiv +#define glVertexAttribP2ui gl3wVertexAttribP2ui +#define glVertexAttribP2uiv gl3wVertexAttribP2uiv +#define glVertexAttribP3ui gl3wVertexAttribP3ui +#define glVertexAttribP3uiv gl3wVertexAttribP3uiv +#define glVertexAttribP4ui gl3wVertexAttribP4ui +#define glVertexAttribP4uiv gl3wVertexAttribP4uiv +#define glVertexAttribPointer gl3wVertexAttribPointer +#define glVertexBindingDivisor gl3wVertexBindingDivisor +#define glViewport gl3wViewport +#define glViewportArrayv gl3wViewportArrayv +#define glViewportIndexedf gl3wViewportIndexedf +#define glViewportIndexedfv gl3wViewportIndexedfv +#define glWaitSync gl3wWaitSync + +#ifdef __cplusplus +} +#endif + +#endif diff --git a/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/gl3w/include/GL/glcorearb.h b/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/gl3w/include/GL/glcorearb.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000..be94baf --- /dev/null +++ b/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/gl3w/include/GL/glcorearb.h @@ -0,0 +1,3621 @@ +#ifndef __glcorearb_h_ +#define __glcorearb_h_ 1 + +#ifdef __cplusplus +extern "C" { +#endif + +/* +** Copyright (c) 2013-2016 The Khronos Group Inc. +** +** Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a +** copy of this software and/or associated documentation files (the +** "Materials"), to deal in the Materials without restriction, including +** without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, +** distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Materials, and to +** permit persons to whom the Materials are furnished to do so, subject to +** the following conditions: +** +** The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included +** in all copies or substantial portions of the Materials. +** +** THE MATERIALS ARE PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, +** EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF +** MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. +** IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY +** CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, +** TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE +** MATERIALS OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE MATERIALS. +*/ +/* +** This header is generated from the Khronos OpenGL / OpenGL ES XML +** API Registry. The current version of the Registry, generator scripts +** used to make the header, and the header can be found at +** http://www.opengl.org/registry/ +** +** Khronos $Revision: 32433 $ on $Date: 2016-02-10 02:02:08 -0500 (Wed, 10 Feb 2016) $ +*/ + +#if defined(_WIN32) && !defined(APIENTRY) && !defined(__CYGWIN__) && !defined(__SCITECH_SNAP__) +#ifndef WIN32_LEAN_AND_MEAN +#define WIN32_LEAN_AND_MEAN 1 +#endif +#include +#endif + +#ifndef APIENTRY +#define APIENTRY +#endif +#ifndef APIENTRYP +#define APIENTRYP APIENTRY * +#endif +#ifndef GLAPI +#define GLAPI extern +#endif + +/* glcorearb.h is for use with OpenGL core profile implementations. +** It should should be placed in the same directory as gl.h and +** included as . +** +** glcorearb.h includes only APIs in the latest OpenGL core profile +** implementation together with APIs in newer ARB extensions which +** can be supported by the core profile. It does not, and never will +** include functionality removed from the core profile, such as +** fixed-function vertex and fragment processing. +** +** Do not #include both and either of or +** in the same source file. +*/ + +/* Generated C header for: + * API: gl + * Profile: core + * Versions considered: .* + * Versions emitted: .* + * Default extensions included: glcore + * Additional extensions included: _nomatch_^ + * Extensions removed: _nomatch_^ + */ + +#ifndef GL_VERSION_1_0 +#define GL_VERSION_1_0 1 +typedef void GLvoid; +typedef unsigned int GLenum; +typedef float GLfloat; +typedef int GLint; +typedef int GLsizei; +typedef unsigned int GLbitfield; +typedef double GLdouble; +typedef unsigned int GLuint; +typedef unsigned char GLboolean; +typedef unsigned char GLubyte; +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLCULLFACEPROC) (GLenum mode); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLFRONTFACEPROC) (GLenum mode); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLHINTPROC) (GLenum target, GLenum mode); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLLINEWIDTHPROC) (GLfloat width); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPOINTSIZEPROC) (GLfloat size); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPOLYGONMODEPROC) (GLenum face, GLenum mode); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLSCISSORPROC) (GLint x, GLint y, GLsizei width, GLsizei height); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLTEXPARAMETERFPROC) (GLenum target, GLenum pname, GLfloat param); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLTEXPARAMETERFVPROC) (GLenum target, GLenum pname, const GLfloat *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLTEXPARAMETERIPROC) (GLenum target, GLenum pname, GLint param); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLTEXPARAMETERIVPROC) (GLenum target, GLenum pname, const GLint *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLTEXIMAGE1DPROC) (GLenum target, GLint level, GLint internalformat, GLsizei width, GLint border, GLenum format, GLenum type, const void *pixels); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLTEXIMAGE2DPROC) (GLenum target, GLint level, GLint internalformat, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLint border, GLenum format, GLenum type, const void *pixels); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDRAWBUFFERPROC) (GLenum buf); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLCLEARPROC) (GLbitfield mask); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLCLEARCOLORPROC) (GLfloat red, GLfloat green, GLfloat blue, GLfloat alpha); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLCLEARSTENCILPROC) (GLint s); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLCLEARDEPTHPROC) (GLdouble depth); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLSTENCILMASKPROC) (GLuint mask); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLCOLORMASKPROC) (GLboolean red, GLboolean green, GLboolean blue, GLboolean alpha); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDEPTHMASKPROC) (GLboolean flag); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDISABLEPROC) (GLenum cap); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLENABLEPROC) (GLenum cap); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLFINISHPROC) (void); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLFLUSHPROC) (void); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLBLENDFUNCPROC) (GLenum sfactor, GLenum dfactor); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLLOGICOPPROC) (GLenum opcode); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLSTENCILFUNCPROC) (GLenum func, GLint ref, GLuint mask); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLSTENCILOPPROC) (GLenum fail, GLenum zfail, GLenum zpass); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDEPTHFUNCPROC) (GLenum func); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPIXELSTOREFPROC) (GLenum pname, GLfloat param); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPIXELSTOREIPROC) (GLenum pname, GLint param); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLREADBUFFERPROC) (GLenum src); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLREADPIXELSPROC) (GLint x, GLint y, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLenum format, GLenum type, void *pixels); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETBOOLEANVPROC) (GLenum pname, GLboolean *data); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETDOUBLEVPROC) (GLenum pname, GLdouble *data); +typedef GLenum (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETERRORPROC) (void); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETFLOATVPROC) (GLenum pname, GLfloat *data); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETINTEGERVPROC) (GLenum pname, GLint *data); +typedef const GLubyte *(APIENTRYP PFNGLGETSTRINGPROC) (GLenum name); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETTEXIMAGEPROC) (GLenum target, GLint level, GLenum format, GLenum type, void *pixels); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETTEXPARAMETERFVPROC) (GLenum target, GLenum pname, GLfloat *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETTEXPARAMETERIVPROC) (GLenum target, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETTEXLEVELPARAMETERFVPROC) (GLenum target, GLint level, GLenum pname, GLfloat *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETTEXLEVELPARAMETERIVPROC) (GLenum target, GLint level, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +typedef GLboolean (APIENTRYP PFNGLISENABLEDPROC) (GLenum cap); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDEPTHRANGEPROC) (GLdouble near, GLdouble far); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVIEWPORTPROC) (GLint x, GLint y, GLsizei width, GLsizei height); +#ifdef GL_GLEXT_PROTOTYPES +GLAPI void APIENTRY glCullFace (GLenum mode); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glFrontFace (GLenum mode); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glHint (GLenum target, GLenum mode); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glLineWidth (GLfloat width); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glPointSize (GLfloat size); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glPolygonMode (GLenum face, GLenum mode); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glScissor (GLint x, GLint y, GLsizei width, GLsizei height); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glTexParameterf (GLenum target, GLenum pname, GLfloat param); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glTexParameterfv (GLenum target, GLenum pname, const GLfloat *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glTexParameteri (GLenum target, GLenum pname, GLint param); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glTexParameteriv (GLenum target, GLenum pname, const GLint *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glTexImage1D (GLenum target, GLint level, GLint internalformat, GLsizei width, GLint border, GLenum format, GLenum type, const void *pixels); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glTexImage2D (GLenum target, GLint level, GLint internalformat, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLint border, GLenum format, GLenum type, const void *pixels); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDrawBuffer (GLenum buf); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glClear (GLbitfield mask); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glClearColor (GLfloat red, GLfloat green, GLfloat blue, GLfloat alpha); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glClearStencil (GLint s); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glClearDepth (GLdouble depth); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glStencilMask (GLuint mask); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glColorMask (GLboolean red, GLboolean green, GLboolean blue, GLboolean alpha); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDepthMask (GLboolean flag); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDisable (GLenum cap); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glEnable (GLenum cap); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glFinish (void); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glFlush (void); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glBlendFunc (GLenum sfactor, GLenum dfactor); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glLogicOp (GLenum opcode); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glStencilFunc (GLenum func, GLint ref, GLuint mask); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glStencilOp (GLenum fail, GLenum zfail, GLenum zpass); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDepthFunc (GLenum func); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glPixelStoref (GLenum pname, GLfloat param); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glPixelStorei (GLenum pname, GLint param); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glReadBuffer (GLenum src); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glReadPixels (GLint x, GLint y, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLenum format, GLenum type, void *pixels); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetBooleanv (GLenum pname, GLboolean *data); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetDoublev (GLenum pname, GLdouble *data); +GLAPI GLenum APIENTRY glGetError (void); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetFloatv (GLenum pname, GLfloat *data); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetIntegerv (GLenum pname, GLint *data); +GLAPI const GLubyte *APIENTRY glGetString (GLenum name); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetTexImage (GLenum target, GLint level, GLenum format, GLenum type, void *pixels); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetTexParameterfv (GLenum target, GLenum pname, GLfloat *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetTexParameteriv (GLenum target, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetTexLevelParameterfv (GLenum target, GLint level, GLenum pname, GLfloat *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetTexLevelParameteriv (GLenum target, GLint level, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +GLAPI GLboolean APIENTRY glIsEnabled (GLenum cap); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDepthRange (GLdouble near, GLdouble far); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glViewport (GLint x, GLint y, GLsizei width, GLsizei height); +#endif +#endif /* GL_VERSION_1_0 */ + +#ifndef GL_VERSION_1_1 +#define GL_VERSION_1_1 1 +typedef float GLclampf; +typedef double GLclampd; +#define GL_DEPTH_BUFFER_BIT 0x00000100 +#define GL_STENCIL_BUFFER_BIT 0x00000400 +#define GL_COLOR_BUFFER_BIT 0x00004000 +#define GL_FALSE 0 +#define GL_TRUE 1 +#define GL_POINTS 0x0000 +#define GL_LINES 0x0001 +#define GL_LINE_LOOP 0x0002 +#define GL_LINE_STRIP 0x0003 +#define GL_TRIANGLES 0x0004 +#define GL_TRIANGLE_STRIP 0x0005 +#define GL_TRIANGLE_FAN 0x0006 +#define GL_QUADS 0x0007 +#define GL_NEVER 0x0200 +#define GL_LESS 0x0201 +#define GL_EQUAL 0x0202 +#define GL_LEQUAL 0x0203 +#define GL_GREATER 0x0204 +#define GL_NOTEQUAL 0x0205 +#define GL_GEQUAL 0x0206 +#define GL_ALWAYS 0x0207 +#define GL_ZERO 0 +#define GL_ONE 1 +#define GL_SRC_COLOR 0x0300 +#define GL_ONE_MINUS_SRC_COLOR 0x0301 +#define GL_SRC_ALPHA 0x0302 +#define GL_ONE_MINUS_SRC_ALPHA 0x0303 +#define GL_DST_ALPHA 0x0304 +#define GL_ONE_MINUS_DST_ALPHA 0x0305 +#define GL_DST_COLOR 0x0306 +#define GL_ONE_MINUS_DST_COLOR 0x0307 +#define GL_SRC_ALPHA_SATURATE 0x0308 +#define GL_NONE 0 +#define GL_FRONT_LEFT 0x0400 +#define GL_FRONT_RIGHT 0x0401 +#define GL_BACK_LEFT 0x0402 +#define GL_BACK_RIGHT 0x0403 +#define GL_FRONT 0x0404 +#define GL_BACK 0x0405 +#define GL_LEFT 0x0406 +#define GL_RIGHT 0x0407 +#define GL_FRONT_AND_BACK 0x0408 +#define GL_NO_ERROR 0 +#define GL_INVALID_ENUM 0x0500 +#define GL_INVALID_VALUE 0x0501 +#define GL_INVALID_OPERATION 0x0502 +#define GL_OUT_OF_MEMORY 0x0505 +#define GL_CW 0x0900 +#define GL_CCW 0x0901 +#define GL_POINT_SIZE 0x0B11 +#define GL_POINT_SIZE_RANGE 0x0B12 +#define GL_POINT_SIZE_GRANULARITY 0x0B13 +#define GL_LINE_SMOOTH 0x0B20 +#define GL_LINE_WIDTH 0x0B21 +#define GL_LINE_WIDTH_RANGE 0x0B22 +#define GL_LINE_WIDTH_GRANULARITY 0x0B23 +#define GL_POLYGON_MODE 0x0B40 +#define GL_POLYGON_SMOOTH 0x0B41 +#define GL_CULL_FACE 0x0B44 +#define GL_CULL_FACE_MODE 0x0B45 +#define GL_FRONT_FACE 0x0B46 +#define GL_DEPTH_RANGE 0x0B70 +#define GL_DEPTH_TEST 0x0B71 +#define GL_DEPTH_WRITEMASK 0x0B72 +#define GL_DEPTH_CLEAR_VALUE 0x0B73 +#define GL_DEPTH_FUNC 0x0B74 +#define GL_STENCIL_TEST 0x0B90 +#define GL_STENCIL_CLEAR_VALUE 0x0B91 +#define GL_STENCIL_FUNC 0x0B92 +#define GL_STENCIL_VALUE_MASK 0x0B93 +#define GL_STENCIL_FAIL 0x0B94 +#define GL_STENCIL_PASS_DEPTH_FAIL 0x0B95 +#define GL_STENCIL_PASS_DEPTH_PASS 0x0B96 +#define GL_STENCIL_REF 0x0B97 +#define GL_STENCIL_WRITEMASK 0x0B98 +#define GL_VIEWPORT 0x0BA2 +#define GL_DITHER 0x0BD0 +#define GL_BLEND_DST 0x0BE0 +#define GL_BLEND_SRC 0x0BE1 +#define GL_BLEND 0x0BE2 +#define GL_LOGIC_OP_MODE 0x0BF0 +#define GL_COLOR_LOGIC_OP 0x0BF2 +#define GL_DRAW_BUFFER 0x0C01 +#define GL_READ_BUFFER 0x0C02 +#define GL_SCISSOR_BOX 0x0C10 +#define GL_SCISSOR_TEST 0x0C11 +#define GL_COLOR_CLEAR_VALUE 0x0C22 +#define GL_COLOR_WRITEMASK 0x0C23 +#define GL_DOUBLEBUFFER 0x0C32 +#define GL_STEREO 0x0C33 +#define GL_LINE_SMOOTH_HINT 0x0C52 +#define GL_POLYGON_SMOOTH_HINT 0x0C53 +#define GL_UNPACK_SWAP_BYTES 0x0CF0 +#define GL_UNPACK_LSB_FIRST 0x0CF1 +#define GL_UNPACK_ROW_LENGTH 0x0CF2 +#define GL_UNPACK_SKIP_ROWS 0x0CF3 +#define GL_UNPACK_SKIP_PIXELS 0x0CF4 +#define GL_UNPACK_ALIGNMENT 0x0CF5 +#define GL_PACK_SWAP_BYTES 0x0D00 +#define GL_PACK_LSB_FIRST 0x0D01 +#define GL_PACK_ROW_LENGTH 0x0D02 +#define GL_PACK_SKIP_ROWS 0x0D03 +#define GL_PACK_SKIP_PIXELS 0x0D04 +#define GL_PACK_ALIGNMENT 0x0D05 +#define GL_MAX_TEXTURE_SIZE 0x0D33 +#define GL_MAX_VIEWPORT_DIMS 0x0D3A +#define GL_SUBPIXEL_BITS 0x0D50 +#define GL_TEXTURE_1D 0x0DE0 +#define GL_TEXTURE_2D 0x0DE1 +#define GL_POLYGON_OFFSET_UNITS 0x2A00 +#define GL_POLYGON_OFFSET_POINT 0x2A01 +#define GL_POLYGON_OFFSET_LINE 0x2A02 +#define GL_POLYGON_OFFSET_FILL 0x8037 +#define GL_POLYGON_OFFSET_FACTOR 0x8038 +#define GL_TEXTURE_BINDING_1D 0x8068 +#define GL_TEXTURE_BINDING_2D 0x8069 +#define GL_TEXTURE_WIDTH 0x1000 +#define GL_TEXTURE_HEIGHT 0x1001 +#define GL_TEXTURE_INTERNAL_FORMAT 0x1003 +#define GL_TEXTURE_BORDER_COLOR 0x1004 +#define GL_TEXTURE_RED_SIZE 0x805C +#define GL_TEXTURE_GREEN_SIZE 0x805D +#define GL_TEXTURE_BLUE_SIZE 0x805E +#define GL_TEXTURE_ALPHA_SIZE 0x805F +#define GL_DONT_CARE 0x1100 +#define GL_FASTEST 0x1101 +#define GL_NICEST 0x1102 +#define GL_BYTE 0x1400 +#define GL_UNSIGNED_BYTE 0x1401 +#define GL_SHORT 0x1402 +#define GL_UNSIGNED_SHORT 0x1403 +#define GL_INT 0x1404 +#define GL_UNSIGNED_INT 0x1405 +#define GL_FLOAT 0x1406 +#define GL_DOUBLE 0x140A +#define GL_STACK_OVERFLOW 0x0503 +#define GL_STACK_UNDERFLOW 0x0504 +#define GL_CLEAR 0x1500 +#define GL_AND 0x1501 +#define GL_AND_REVERSE 0x1502 +#define GL_COPY 0x1503 +#define GL_AND_INVERTED 0x1504 +#define GL_NOOP 0x1505 +#define GL_XOR 0x1506 +#define GL_OR 0x1507 +#define GL_NOR 0x1508 +#define GL_EQUIV 0x1509 +#define GL_INVERT 0x150A +#define GL_OR_REVERSE 0x150B +#define GL_COPY_INVERTED 0x150C +#define GL_OR_INVERTED 0x150D +#define GL_NAND 0x150E +#define GL_SET 0x150F +#define GL_TEXTURE 0x1702 +#define GL_COLOR 0x1800 +#define GL_DEPTH 0x1801 +#define GL_STENCIL 0x1802 +#define GL_STENCIL_INDEX 0x1901 +#define GL_DEPTH_COMPONENT 0x1902 +#define GL_RED 0x1903 +#define GL_GREEN 0x1904 +#define GL_BLUE 0x1905 +#define GL_ALPHA 0x1906 +#define GL_RGB 0x1907 +#define GL_RGBA 0x1908 +#define GL_POINT 0x1B00 +#define GL_LINE 0x1B01 +#define GL_FILL 0x1B02 +#define GL_KEEP 0x1E00 +#define GL_REPLACE 0x1E01 +#define GL_INCR 0x1E02 +#define GL_DECR 0x1E03 +#define GL_VENDOR 0x1F00 +#define GL_RENDERER 0x1F01 +#define GL_VERSION 0x1F02 +#define GL_EXTENSIONS 0x1F03 +#define GL_NEAREST 0x2600 +#define GL_LINEAR 0x2601 +#define GL_NEAREST_MIPMAP_NEAREST 0x2700 +#define GL_LINEAR_MIPMAP_NEAREST 0x2701 +#define GL_NEAREST_MIPMAP_LINEAR 0x2702 +#define GL_LINEAR_MIPMAP_LINEAR 0x2703 +#define GL_TEXTURE_MAG_FILTER 0x2800 +#define GL_TEXTURE_MIN_FILTER 0x2801 +#define GL_TEXTURE_WRAP_S 0x2802 +#define GL_TEXTURE_WRAP_T 0x2803 +#define GL_PROXY_TEXTURE_1D 0x8063 +#define GL_PROXY_TEXTURE_2D 0x8064 +#define GL_REPEAT 0x2901 +#define GL_R3_G3_B2 0x2A10 +#define GL_RGB4 0x804F +#define GL_RGB5 0x8050 +#define GL_RGB8 0x8051 +#define GL_RGB10 0x8052 +#define GL_RGB12 0x8053 +#define GL_RGB16 0x8054 +#define GL_RGBA2 0x8055 +#define GL_RGBA4 0x8056 +#define GL_RGB5_A1 0x8057 +#define GL_RGBA8 0x8058 +#define GL_RGB10_A2 0x8059 +#define GL_RGBA12 0x805A +#define GL_RGBA16 0x805B +#define GL_VERTEX_ARRAY 0x8074 +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDRAWARRAYSPROC) (GLenum mode, GLint first, GLsizei count); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDRAWELEMENTSPROC) (GLenum mode, GLsizei count, GLenum type, const void *indices); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETPOINTERVPROC) (GLenum pname, void **params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPOLYGONOFFSETPROC) (GLfloat factor, GLfloat units); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLCOPYTEXIMAGE1DPROC) (GLenum target, GLint level, GLenum internalformat, GLint x, GLint y, GLsizei width, GLint border); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLCOPYTEXIMAGE2DPROC) (GLenum target, GLint level, GLenum internalformat, GLint x, GLint y, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLint border); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLCOPYTEXSUBIMAGE1DPROC) (GLenum target, GLint level, GLint xoffset, GLint x, GLint y, GLsizei width); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLCOPYTEXSUBIMAGE2DPROC) (GLenum target, GLint level, GLint xoffset, GLint yoffset, GLint x, GLint y, GLsizei width, GLsizei height); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLTEXSUBIMAGE1DPROC) (GLenum target, GLint level, GLint xoffset, GLsizei width, GLenum format, GLenum type, const void *pixels); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLTEXSUBIMAGE2DPROC) (GLenum target, GLint level, GLint xoffset, GLint yoffset, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLenum format, GLenum type, const void *pixels); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLBINDTEXTUREPROC) (GLenum target, GLuint texture); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDELETETEXTURESPROC) (GLsizei n, const GLuint *textures); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGENTEXTURESPROC) (GLsizei n, GLuint *textures); +typedef GLboolean (APIENTRYP PFNGLISTEXTUREPROC) (GLuint texture); +#ifdef GL_GLEXT_PROTOTYPES +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDrawArrays (GLenum mode, GLint first, GLsizei count); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDrawElements (GLenum mode, GLsizei count, GLenum type, const void *indices); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetPointerv (GLenum pname, void **params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glPolygonOffset (GLfloat factor, GLfloat units); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glCopyTexImage1D (GLenum target, GLint level, GLenum internalformat, GLint x, GLint y, GLsizei width, GLint border); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glCopyTexImage2D (GLenum target, GLint level, GLenum internalformat, GLint x, GLint y, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLint border); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glCopyTexSubImage1D (GLenum target, GLint level, GLint xoffset, GLint x, GLint y, GLsizei width); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glCopyTexSubImage2D (GLenum target, GLint level, GLint xoffset, GLint yoffset, GLint x, GLint y, GLsizei width, GLsizei height); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glTexSubImage1D (GLenum target, GLint level, GLint xoffset, GLsizei width, GLenum format, GLenum type, const void *pixels); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glTexSubImage2D (GLenum target, GLint level, GLint xoffset, GLint yoffset, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLenum format, GLenum type, const void *pixels); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glBindTexture (GLenum target, GLuint texture); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDeleteTextures (GLsizei n, const GLuint *textures); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGenTextures (GLsizei n, GLuint *textures); +GLAPI GLboolean APIENTRY glIsTexture (GLuint texture); +#endif +#endif /* GL_VERSION_1_1 */ + +#ifndef GL_VERSION_1_2 +#define GL_VERSION_1_2 1 +#define GL_UNSIGNED_BYTE_3_3_2 0x8032 +#define GL_UNSIGNED_SHORT_4_4_4_4 0x8033 +#define GL_UNSIGNED_SHORT_5_5_5_1 0x8034 +#define GL_UNSIGNED_INT_8_8_8_8 0x8035 +#define GL_UNSIGNED_INT_10_10_10_2 0x8036 +#define GL_TEXTURE_BINDING_3D 0x806A +#define GL_PACK_SKIP_IMAGES 0x806B +#define GL_PACK_IMAGE_HEIGHT 0x806C +#define GL_UNPACK_SKIP_IMAGES 0x806D +#define GL_UNPACK_IMAGE_HEIGHT 0x806E +#define GL_TEXTURE_3D 0x806F +#define GL_PROXY_TEXTURE_3D 0x8070 +#define GL_TEXTURE_DEPTH 0x8071 +#define GL_TEXTURE_WRAP_R 0x8072 +#define GL_MAX_3D_TEXTURE_SIZE 0x8073 +#define GL_UNSIGNED_BYTE_2_3_3_REV 0x8362 +#define GL_UNSIGNED_SHORT_5_6_5 0x8363 +#define GL_UNSIGNED_SHORT_5_6_5_REV 0x8364 +#define GL_UNSIGNED_SHORT_4_4_4_4_REV 0x8365 +#define GL_UNSIGNED_SHORT_1_5_5_5_REV 0x8366 +#define GL_UNSIGNED_INT_8_8_8_8_REV 0x8367 +#define GL_UNSIGNED_INT_2_10_10_10_REV 0x8368 +#define GL_BGR 0x80E0 +#define GL_BGRA 0x80E1 +#define GL_MAX_ELEMENTS_VERTICES 0x80E8 +#define GL_MAX_ELEMENTS_INDICES 0x80E9 +#define GL_CLAMP_TO_EDGE 0x812F +#define GL_TEXTURE_MIN_LOD 0x813A +#define GL_TEXTURE_MAX_LOD 0x813B +#define GL_TEXTURE_BASE_LEVEL 0x813C +#define GL_TEXTURE_MAX_LEVEL 0x813D +#define GL_SMOOTH_POINT_SIZE_RANGE 0x0B12 +#define GL_SMOOTH_POINT_SIZE_GRANULARITY 0x0B13 +#define GL_SMOOTH_LINE_WIDTH_RANGE 0x0B22 +#define GL_SMOOTH_LINE_WIDTH_GRANULARITY 0x0B23 +#define GL_ALIASED_LINE_WIDTH_RANGE 0x846E +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDRAWRANGEELEMENTSPROC) (GLenum mode, GLuint start, GLuint end, GLsizei count, GLenum type, const void *indices); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLTEXIMAGE3DPROC) (GLenum target, GLint level, GLint internalformat, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLsizei depth, GLint border, GLenum format, GLenum type, const void *pixels); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLTEXSUBIMAGE3DPROC) (GLenum target, GLint level, GLint xoffset, GLint yoffset, GLint zoffset, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLsizei depth, GLenum format, GLenum type, const void *pixels); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLCOPYTEXSUBIMAGE3DPROC) (GLenum target, GLint level, GLint xoffset, GLint yoffset, GLint zoffset, GLint x, GLint y, GLsizei width, GLsizei height); +#ifdef GL_GLEXT_PROTOTYPES +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDrawRangeElements (GLenum mode, GLuint start, GLuint end, GLsizei count, GLenum type, const void *indices); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glTexImage3D (GLenum target, GLint level, GLint internalformat, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLsizei depth, GLint border, GLenum format, GLenum type, const void *pixels); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glTexSubImage3D (GLenum target, GLint level, GLint xoffset, GLint yoffset, GLint zoffset, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLsizei depth, GLenum format, GLenum type, const void *pixels); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glCopyTexSubImage3D (GLenum target, GLint level, GLint xoffset, GLint yoffset, GLint zoffset, GLint x, GLint y, GLsizei width, GLsizei height); +#endif +#endif /* GL_VERSION_1_2 */ + +#ifndef GL_VERSION_1_3 +#define GL_VERSION_1_3 1 +#define GL_TEXTURE0 0x84C0 +#define GL_TEXTURE1 0x84C1 +#define GL_TEXTURE2 0x84C2 +#define GL_TEXTURE3 0x84C3 +#define GL_TEXTURE4 0x84C4 +#define GL_TEXTURE5 0x84C5 +#define GL_TEXTURE6 0x84C6 +#define GL_TEXTURE7 0x84C7 +#define GL_TEXTURE8 0x84C8 +#define GL_TEXTURE9 0x84C9 +#define GL_TEXTURE10 0x84CA +#define GL_TEXTURE11 0x84CB +#define GL_TEXTURE12 0x84CC +#define GL_TEXTURE13 0x84CD +#define GL_TEXTURE14 0x84CE +#define GL_TEXTURE15 0x84CF +#define GL_TEXTURE16 0x84D0 +#define GL_TEXTURE17 0x84D1 +#define GL_TEXTURE18 0x84D2 +#define GL_TEXTURE19 0x84D3 +#define GL_TEXTURE20 0x84D4 +#define GL_TEXTURE21 0x84D5 +#define GL_TEXTURE22 0x84D6 +#define GL_TEXTURE23 0x84D7 +#define GL_TEXTURE24 0x84D8 +#define GL_TEXTURE25 0x84D9 +#define GL_TEXTURE26 0x84DA +#define GL_TEXTURE27 0x84DB +#define GL_TEXTURE28 0x84DC +#define GL_TEXTURE29 0x84DD +#define GL_TEXTURE30 0x84DE +#define GL_TEXTURE31 0x84DF +#define GL_ACTIVE_TEXTURE 0x84E0 +#define GL_MULTISAMPLE 0x809D +#define GL_SAMPLE_ALPHA_TO_COVERAGE 0x809E +#define GL_SAMPLE_ALPHA_TO_ONE 0x809F +#define GL_SAMPLE_COVERAGE 0x80A0 +#define GL_SAMPLE_BUFFERS 0x80A8 +#define GL_SAMPLES 0x80A9 +#define GL_SAMPLE_COVERAGE_VALUE 0x80AA +#define GL_SAMPLE_COVERAGE_INVERT 0x80AB +#define GL_TEXTURE_CUBE_MAP 0x8513 +#define GL_TEXTURE_BINDING_CUBE_MAP 0x8514 +#define GL_TEXTURE_CUBE_MAP_POSITIVE_X 0x8515 +#define GL_TEXTURE_CUBE_MAP_NEGATIVE_X 0x8516 +#define GL_TEXTURE_CUBE_MAP_POSITIVE_Y 0x8517 +#define GL_TEXTURE_CUBE_MAP_NEGATIVE_Y 0x8518 +#define GL_TEXTURE_CUBE_MAP_POSITIVE_Z 0x8519 +#define GL_TEXTURE_CUBE_MAP_NEGATIVE_Z 0x851A +#define GL_PROXY_TEXTURE_CUBE_MAP 0x851B +#define GL_MAX_CUBE_MAP_TEXTURE_SIZE 0x851C +#define GL_COMPRESSED_RGB 0x84ED +#define GL_COMPRESSED_RGBA 0x84EE +#define GL_TEXTURE_COMPRESSION_HINT 0x84EF +#define GL_TEXTURE_COMPRESSED_IMAGE_SIZE 0x86A0 +#define GL_TEXTURE_COMPRESSED 0x86A1 +#define GL_NUM_COMPRESSED_TEXTURE_FORMATS 0x86A2 +#define GL_COMPRESSED_TEXTURE_FORMATS 0x86A3 +#define GL_CLAMP_TO_BORDER 0x812D +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLACTIVETEXTUREPROC) (GLenum texture); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLSAMPLECOVERAGEPROC) (GLfloat value, GLboolean invert); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLCOMPRESSEDTEXIMAGE3DPROC) (GLenum target, GLint level, GLenum internalformat, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLsizei depth, GLint border, GLsizei imageSize, const void *data); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLCOMPRESSEDTEXIMAGE2DPROC) (GLenum target, GLint level, GLenum internalformat, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLint border, GLsizei imageSize, const void *data); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLCOMPRESSEDTEXIMAGE1DPROC) (GLenum target, GLint level, GLenum internalformat, GLsizei width, GLint border, GLsizei imageSize, const void *data); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLCOMPRESSEDTEXSUBIMAGE3DPROC) (GLenum target, GLint level, GLint xoffset, GLint yoffset, GLint zoffset, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLsizei depth, GLenum format, GLsizei imageSize, const void *data); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLCOMPRESSEDTEXSUBIMAGE2DPROC) (GLenum target, GLint level, GLint xoffset, GLint yoffset, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLenum format, GLsizei imageSize, const void *data); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLCOMPRESSEDTEXSUBIMAGE1DPROC) (GLenum target, GLint level, GLint xoffset, GLsizei width, GLenum format, GLsizei imageSize, const void *data); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETCOMPRESSEDTEXIMAGEPROC) (GLenum target, GLint level, void *img); +#ifdef GL_GLEXT_PROTOTYPES +GLAPI void APIENTRY glActiveTexture (GLenum texture); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glSampleCoverage (GLfloat value, GLboolean invert); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glCompressedTexImage3D (GLenum target, GLint level, GLenum internalformat, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLsizei depth, GLint border, GLsizei imageSize, const void *data); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glCompressedTexImage2D (GLenum target, GLint level, GLenum internalformat, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLint border, GLsizei imageSize, const void *data); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glCompressedTexImage1D (GLenum target, GLint level, GLenum internalformat, GLsizei width, GLint border, GLsizei imageSize, const void *data); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glCompressedTexSubImage3D (GLenum target, GLint level, GLint xoffset, GLint yoffset, GLint zoffset, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLsizei depth, GLenum format, GLsizei imageSize, const void *data); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glCompressedTexSubImage2D (GLenum target, GLint level, GLint xoffset, GLint yoffset, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLenum format, GLsizei imageSize, const void *data); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glCompressedTexSubImage1D (GLenum target, GLint level, GLint xoffset, GLsizei width, GLenum format, GLsizei imageSize, const void *data); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetCompressedTexImage (GLenum target, GLint level, void *img); +#endif +#endif /* GL_VERSION_1_3 */ + +#ifndef GL_VERSION_1_4 +#define GL_VERSION_1_4 1 +#define GL_BLEND_DST_RGB 0x80C8 +#define GL_BLEND_SRC_RGB 0x80C9 +#define GL_BLEND_DST_ALPHA 0x80CA +#define GL_BLEND_SRC_ALPHA 0x80CB +#define GL_POINT_FADE_THRESHOLD_SIZE 0x8128 +#define GL_DEPTH_COMPONENT16 0x81A5 +#define GL_DEPTH_COMPONENT24 0x81A6 +#define GL_DEPTH_COMPONENT32 0x81A7 +#define GL_MIRRORED_REPEAT 0x8370 +#define GL_MAX_TEXTURE_LOD_BIAS 0x84FD +#define GL_TEXTURE_LOD_BIAS 0x8501 +#define GL_INCR_WRAP 0x8507 +#define GL_DECR_WRAP 0x8508 +#define GL_TEXTURE_DEPTH_SIZE 0x884A +#define GL_TEXTURE_COMPARE_MODE 0x884C +#define GL_TEXTURE_COMPARE_FUNC 0x884D +#define GL_FUNC_ADD 0x8006 +#define GL_FUNC_SUBTRACT 0x800A +#define GL_FUNC_REVERSE_SUBTRACT 0x800B +#define GL_MIN 0x8007 +#define GL_MAX 0x8008 +#define GL_CONSTANT_COLOR 0x8001 +#define GL_ONE_MINUS_CONSTANT_COLOR 0x8002 +#define GL_CONSTANT_ALPHA 0x8003 +#define GL_ONE_MINUS_CONSTANT_ALPHA 0x8004 +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLBLENDFUNCSEPARATEPROC) (GLenum sfactorRGB, GLenum dfactorRGB, GLenum sfactorAlpha, GLenum dfactorAlpha); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLMULTIDRAWARRAYSPROC) (GLenum mode, const GLint *first, const GLsizei *count, GLsizei drawcount); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLMULTIDRAWELEMENTSPROC) (GLenum mode, const GLsizei *count, GLenum type, const void *const*indices, GLsizei drawcount); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPOINTPARAMETERFPROC) (GLenum pname, GLfloat param); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPOINTPARAMETERFVPROC) (GLenum pname, const GLfloat *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPOINTPARAMETERIPROC) (GLenum pname, GLint param); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPOINTPARAMETERIVPROC) (GLenum pname, const GLint *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLBLENDCOLORPROC) (GLfloat red, GLfloat green, GLfloat blue, GLfloat alpha); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLBLENDEQUATIONPROC) (GLenum mode); +#ifdef GL_GLEXT_PROTOTYPES +GLAPI void APIENTRY glBlendFuncSeparate (GLenum sfactorRGB, GLenum dfactorRGB, GLenum sfactorAlpha, GLenum dfactorAlpha); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glMultiDrawArrays (GLenum mode, const GLint *first, const GLsizei *count, GLsizei drawcount); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glMultiDrawElements (GLenum mode, const GLsizei *count, GLenum type, const void *const*indices, GLsizei drawcount); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glPointParameterf (GLenum pname, GLfloat param); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glPointParameterfv (GLenum pname, const GLfloat *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glPointParameteri (GLenum pname, GLint param); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glPointParameteriv (GLenum pname, const GLint *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glBlendColor (GLfloat red, GLfloat green, GLfloat blue, GLfloat alpha); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glBlendEquation (GLenum mode); +#endif +#endif /* GL_VERSION_1_4 */ + +#ifndef GL_VERSION_1_5 +#define GL_VERSION_1_5 1 +#include +typedef ptrdiff_t GLsizeiptr; +typedef ptrdiff_t GLintptr; +#define GL_BUFFER_SIZE 0x8764 +#define GL_BUFFER_USAGE 0x8765 +#define GL_QUERY_COUNTER_BITS 0x8864 +#define GL_CURRENT_QUERY 0x8865 +#define GL_QUERY_RESULT 0x8866 +#define GL_QUERY_RESULT_AVAILABLE 0x8867 +#define GL_ARRAY_BUFFER 0x8892 +#define GL_ELEMENT_ARRAY_BUFFER 0x8893 +#define GL_ARRAY_BUFFER_BINDING 0x8894 +#define GL_ELEMENT_ARRAY_BUFFER_BINDING 0x8895 +#define GL_VERTEX_ATTRIB_ARRAY_BUFFER_BINDING 0x889F +#define GL_READ_ONLY 0x88B8 +#define GL_WRITE_ONLY 0x88B9 +#define GL_READ_WRITE 0x88BA +#define GL_BUFFER_ACCESS 0x88BB +#define GL_BUFFER_MAPPED 0x88BC +#define GL_BUFFER_MAP_POINTER 0x88BD +#define GL_STREAM_DRAW 0x88E0 +#define GL_STREAM_READ 0x88E1 +#define GL_STREAM_COPY 0x88E2 +#define GL_STATIC_DRAW 0x88E4 +#define GL_STATIC_READ 0x88E5 +#define GL_STATIC_COPY 0x88E6 +#define GL_DYNAMIC_DRAW 0x88E8 +#define GL_DYNAMIC_READ 0x88E9 +#define GL_DYNAMIC_COPY 0x88EA +#define GL_SAMPLES_PASSED 0x8914 +#define GL_SRC1_ALPHA 0x8589 +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGENQUERIESPROC) (GLsizei n, GLuint *ids); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDELETEQUERIESPROC) (GLsizei n, const GLuint *ids); +typedef GLboolean (APIENTRYP PFNGLISQUERYPROC) (GLuint id); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLBEGINQUERYPROC) (GLenum target, GLuint id); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLENDQUERYPROC) (GLenum target); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETQUERYIVPROC) (GLenum target, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETQUERYOBJECTIVPROC) (GLuint id, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETQUERYOBJECTUIVPROC) (GLuint id, GLenum pname, GLuint *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLBINDBUFFERPROC) (GLenum target, GLuint buffer); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDELETEBUFFERSPROC) (GLsizei n, const GLuint *buffers); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGENBUFFERSPROC) (GLsizei n, GLuint *buffers); +typedef GLboolean (APIENTRYP PFNGLISBUFFERPROC) (GLuint buffer); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLBUFFERDATAPROC) (GLenum target, GLsizeiptr size, const void *data, GLenum usage); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLBUFFERSUBDATAPROC) (GLenum target, GLintptr offset, GLsizeiptr size, const void *data); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETBUFFERSUBDATAPROC) (GLenum target, GLintptr offset, GLsizeiptr size, void *data); +typedef void *(APIENTRYP PFNGLMAPBUFFERPROC) (GLenum target, GLenum access); +typedef GLboolean (APIENTRYP PFNGLUNMAPBUFFERPROC) (GLenum target); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETBUFFERPARAMETERIVPROC) (GLenum target, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETBUFFERPOINTERVPROC) (GLenum target, GLenum pname, void **params); +#ifdef GL_GLEXT_PROTOTYPES +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGenQueries (GLsizei n, GLuint *ids); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDeleteQueries (GLsizei n, const GLuint *ids); +GLAPI GLboolean APIENTRY glIsQuery (GLuint id); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glBeginQuery (GLenum target, GLuint id); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glEndQuery (GLenum target); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetQueryiv (GLenum target, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetQueryObjectiv (GLuint id, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetQueryObjectuiv (GLuint id, GLenum pname, GLuint *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glBindBuffer (GLenum target, GLuint buffer); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDeleteBuffers (GLsizei n, const GLuint *buffers); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGenBuffers (GLsizei n, GLuint *buffers); +GLAPI GLboolean APIENTRY glIsBuffer (GLuint buffer); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glBufferData (GLenum target, GLsizeiptr size, const void *data, GLenum usage); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glBufferSubData (GLenum target, GLintptr offset, GLsizeiptr size, const void *data); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetBufferSubData (GLenum target, GLintptr offset, GLsizeiptr size, void *data); +GLAPI void *APIENTRY glMapBuffer (GLenum target, GLenum access); +GLAPI GLboolean APIENTRY glUnmapBuffer (GLenum target); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetBufferParameteriv (GLenum target, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetBufferPointerv (GLenum target, GLenum pname, void **params); +#endif +#endif /* GL_VERSION_1_5 */ + +#ifndef GL_VERSION_2_0 +#define GL_VERSION_2_0 1 +typedef char GLchar; +typedef short GLshort; +typedef signed char GLbyte; +typedef unsigned short GLushort; +#define GL_BLEND_EQUATION_RGB 0x8009 +#define GL_VERTEX_ATTRIB_ARRAY_ENABLED 0x8622 +#define GL_VERTEX_ATTRIB_ARRAY_SIZE 0x8623 +#define GL_VERTEX_ATTRIB_ARRAY_STRIDE 0x8624 +#define GL_VERTEX_ATTRIB_ARRAY_TYPE 0x8625 +#define GL_CURRENT_VERTEX_ATTRIB 0x8626 +#define GL_VERTEX_PROGRAM_POINT_SIZE 0x8642 +#define GL_VERTEX_ATTRIB_ARRAY_POINTER 0x8645 +#define GL_STENCIL_BACK_FUNC 0x8800 +#define GL_STENCIL_BACK_FAIL 0x8801 +#define GL_STENCIL_BACK_PASS_DEPTH_FAIL 0x8802 +#define GL_STENCIL_BACK_PASS_DEPTH_PASS 0x8803 +#define GL_MAX_DRAW_BUFFERS 0x8824 +#define GL_DRAW_BUFFER0 0x8825 +#define GL_DRAW_BUFFER1 0x8826 +#define GL_DRAW_BUFFER2 0x8827 +#define GL_DRAW_BUFFER3 0x8828 +#define GL_DRAW_BUFFER4 0x8829 +#define GL_DRAW_BUFFER5 0x882A +#define GL_DRAW_BUFFER6 0x882B +#define GL_DRAW_BUFFER7 0x882C +#define GL_DRAW_BUFFER8 0x882D +#define GL_DRAW_BUFFER9 0x882E +#define GL_DRAW_BUFFER10 0x882F +#define GL_DRAW_BUFFER11 0x8830 +#define GL_DRAW_BUFFER12 0x8831 +#define GL_DRAW_BUFFER13 0x8832 +#define GL_DRAW_BUFFER14 0x8833 +#define GL_DRAW_BUFFER15 0x8834 +#define GL_BLEND_EQUATION_ALPHA 0x883D +#define GL_MAX_VERTEX_ATTRIBS 0x8869 +#define GL_VERTEX_ATTRIB_ARRAY_NORMALIZED 0x886A +#define GL_MAX_TEXTURE_IMAGE_UNITS 0x8872 +#define GL_FRAGMENT_SHADER 0x8B30 +#define GL_VERTEX_SHADER 0x8B31 +#define GL_MAX_FRAGMENT_UNIFORM_COMPONENTS 0x8B49 +#define GL_MAX_VERTEX_UNIFORM_COMPONENTS 0x8B4A +#define GL_MAX_VARYING_FLOATS 0x8B4B +#define GL_MAX_VERTEX_TEXTURE_IMAGE_UNITS 0x8B4C +#define GL_MAX_COMBINED_TEXTURE_IMAGE_UNITS 0x8B4D +#define GL_SHADER_TYPE 0x8B4F +#define GL_FLOAT_VEC2 0x8B50 +#define GL_FLOAT_VEC3 0x8B51 +#define GL_FLOAT_VEC4 0x8B52 +#define GL_INT_VEC2 0x8B53 +#define GL_INT_VEC3 0x8B54 +#define GL_INT_VEC4 0x8B55 +#define GL_BOOL 0x8B56 +#define GL_BOOL_VEC2 0x8B57 +#define GL_BOOL_VEC3 0x8B58 +#define GL_BOOL_VEC4 0x8B59 +#define GL_FLOAT_MAT2 0x8B5A +#define GL_FLOAT_MAT3 0x8B5B +#define GL_FLOAT_MAT4 0x8B5C +#define GL_SAMPLER_1D 0x8B5D +#define GL_SAMPLER_2D 0x8B5E +#define GL_SAMPLER_3D 0x8B5F +#define GL_SAMPLER_CUBE 0x8B60 +#define GL_SAMPLER_1D_SHADOW 0x8B61 +#define GL_SAMPLER_2D_SHADOW 0x8B62 +#define GL_DELETE_STATUS 0x8B80 +#define GL_COMPILE_STATUS 0x8B81 +#define GL_LINK_STATUS 0x8B82 +#define GL_VALIDATE_STATUS 0x8B83 +#define GL_INFO_LOG_LENGTH 0x8B84 +#define GL_ATTACHED_SHADERS 0x8B85 +#define GL_ACTIVE_UNIFORMS 0x8B86 +#define GL_ACTIVE_UNIFORM_MAX_LENGTH 0x8B87 +#define GL_SHADER_SOURCE_LENGTH 0x8B88 +#define GL_ACTIVE_ATTRIBUTES 0x8B89 +#define GL_ACTIVE_ATTRIBUTE_MAX_LENGTH 0x8B8A +#define GL_FRAGMENT_SHADER_DERIVATIVE_HINT 0x8B8B +#define GL_SHADING_LANGUAGE_VERSION 0x8B8C +#define GL_CURRENT_PROGRAM 0x8B8D +#define GL_POINT_SPRITE_COORD_ORIGIN 0x8CA0 +#define GL_LOWER_LEFT 0x8CA1 +#define GL_UPPER_LEFT 0x8CA2 +#define GL_STENCIL_BACK_REF 0x8CA3 +#define GL_STENCIL_BACK_VALUE_MASK 0x8CA4 +#define GL_STENCIL_BACK_WRITEMASK 0x8CA5 +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLBLENDEQUATIONSEPARATEPROC) (GLenum modeRGB, GLenum modeAlpha); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDRAWBUFFERSPROC) (GLsizei n, const GLenum *bufs); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLSTENCILOPSEPARATEPROC) (GLenum face, GLenum sfail, GLenum dpfail, GLenum dppass); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLSTENCILFUNCSEPARATEPROC) (GLenum face, GLenum func, GLint ref, GLuint mask); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLSTENCILMASKSEPARATEPROC) (GLenum face, GLuint mask); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLATTACHSHADERPROC) (GLuint program, GLuint shader); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLBINDATTRIBLOCATIONPROC) (GLuint program, GLuint index, const GLchar *name); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLCOMPILESHADERPROC) (GLuint shader); +typedef GLuint (APIENTRYP PFNGLCREATEPROGRAMPROC) (void); +typedef GLuint (APIENTRYP PFNGLCREATESHADERPROC) (GLenum type); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDELETEPROGRAMPROC) (GLuint program); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDELETESHADERPROC) (GLuint shader); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDETACHSHADERPROC) (GLuint program, GLuint shader); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDISABLEVERTEXATTRIBARRAYPROC) (GLuint index); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLENABLEVERTEXATTRIBARRAYPROC) (GLuint index); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETACTIVEATTRIBPROC) (GLuint program, GLuint index, GLsizei bufSize, GLsizei *length, GLint *size, GLenum *type, GLchar *name); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETACTIVEUNIFORMPROC) (GLuint program, GLuint index, GLsizei bufSize, GLsizei *length, GLint *size, GLenum *type, GLchar *name); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETATTACHEDSHADERSPROC) (GLuint program, GLsizei maxCount, GLsizei *count, GLuint *shaders); +typedef GLint (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETATTRIBLOCATIONPROC) (GLuint program, const GLchar *name); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETPROGRAMIVPROC) (GLuint program, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETPROGRAMINFOLOGPROC) (GLuint program, GLsizei bufSize, GLsizei *length, GLchar *infoLog); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETSHADERIVPROC) (GLuint shader, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETSHADERINFOLOGPROC) (GLuint shader, GLsizei bufSize, GLsizei *length, GLchar *infoLog); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETSHADERSOURCEPROC) (GLuint shader, GLsizei bufSize, GLsizei *length, GLchar *source); +typedef GLint (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETUNIFORMLOCATIONPROC) (GLuint program, const GLchar *name); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETUNIFORMFVPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLfloat *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETUNIFORMIVPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLint *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETVERTEXATTRIBDVPROC) (GLuint index, GLenum pname, GLdouble *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETVERTEXATTRIBFVPROC) (GLuint index, GLenum pname, GLfloat *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETVERTEXATTRIBIVPROC) (GLuint index, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETVERTEXATTRIBPOINTERVPROC) (GLuint index, GLenum pname, void **pointer); +typedef GLboolean (APIENTRYP PFNGLISPROGRAMPROC) (GLuint program); +typedef GLboolean (APIENTRYP PFNGLISSHADERPROC) (GLuint shader); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLLINKPROGRAMPROC) (GLuint program); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLSHADERSOURCEPROC) (GLuint shader, GLsizei count, const GLchar *const*string, const GLint *length); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLUSEPROGRAMPROC) (GLuint program); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLUNIFORM1FPROC) (GLint location, GLfloat v0); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLUNIFORM2FPROC) (GLint location, GLfloat v0, GLfloat v1); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLUNIFORM3FPROC) (GLint location, GLfloat v0, GLfloat v1, GLfloat v2); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLUNIFORM4FPROC) (GLint location, GLfloat v0, GLfloat v1, GLfloat v2, GLfloat v3); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLUNIFORM1IPROC) (GLint location, GLint v0); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLUNIFORM2IPROC) (GLint location, GLint v0, GLint v1); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLUNIFORM3IPROC) (GLint location, GLint v0, GLint v1, GLint v2); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLUNIFORM4IPROC) (GLint location, GLint v0, GLint v1, GLint v2, GLint v3); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLUNIFORM1FVPROC) (GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLfloat *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLUNIFORM2FVPROC) (GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLfloat *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLUNIFORM3FVPROC) (GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLfloat *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLUNIFORM4FVPROC) (GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLfloat *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLUNIFORM1IVPROC) (GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLint *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLUNIFORM2IVPROC) (GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLint *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLUNIFORM3IVPROC) (GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLint *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLUNIFORM4IVPROC) (GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLint *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX2FVPROC) (GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLfloat *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX3FVPROC) (GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLfloat *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX4FVPROC) (GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLfloat *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVALIDATEPROGRAMPROC) (GLuint program); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB1DPROC) (GLuint index, GLdouble x); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB1DVPROC) (GLuint index, const GLdouble *v); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB1FPROC) (GLuint index, GLfloat x); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB1FVPROC) (GLuint index, const GLfloat *v); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB1SPROC) (GLuint index, GLshort x); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB1SVPROC) (GLuint index, const GLshort *v); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB2DPROC) (GLuint index, GLdouble x, GLdouble y); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB2DVPROC) (GLuint index, const GLdouble *v); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB2FPROC) (GLuint index, GLfloat x, GLfloat y); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB2FVPROC) (GLuint index, const GLfloat *v); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB2SPROC) (GLuint index, GLshort x, GLshort y); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB2SVPROC) (GLuint index, const GLshort *v); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB3DPROC) (GLuint index, GLdouble x, GLdouble y, GLdouble z); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB3DVPROC) (GLuint index, const GLdouble *v); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB3FPROC) (GLuint index, GLfloat x, GLfloat y, GLfloat z); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB3FVPROC) (GLuint index, const GLfloat *v); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB3SPROC) (GLuint index, GLshort x, GLshort y, GLshort z); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB3SVPROC) (GLuint index, const GLshort *v); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4NBVPROC) (GLuint index, const GLbyte *v); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4NIVPROC) (GLuint index, const GLint *v); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4NSVPROC) (GLuint index, const GLshort *v); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4NUBPROC) (GLuint index, GLubyte x, GLubyte y, GLubyte z, GLubyte w); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4NUBVPROC) (GLuint index, const GLubyte *v); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4NUIVPROC) (GLuint index, const GLuint *v); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4NUSVPROC) (GLuint index, const GLushort *v); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4BVPROC) (GLuint index, const GLbyte *v); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4DPROC) (GLuint index, GLdouble x, GLdouble y, GLdouble z, GLdouble w); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4DVPROC) (GLuint index, const GLdouble *v); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4FPROC) (GLuint index, GLfloat x, GLfloat y, GLfloat z, GLfloat w); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4FVPROC) (GLuint index, const GLfloat *v); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4IVPROC) (GLuint index, const GLint *v); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4SPROC) (GLuint index, GLshort x, GLshort y, GLshort z, GLshort w); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4SVPROC) (GLuint index, const GLshort *v); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4UBVPROC) (GLuint index, const GLubyte *v); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4UIVPROC) (GLuint index, const GLuint *v); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4USVPROC) (GLuint index, const GLushort *v); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBPOINTERPROC) (GLuint index, GLint size, GLenum type, GLboolean normalized, GLsizei stride, const void *pointer); +#ifdef GL_GLEXT_PROTOTYPES +GLAPI void APIENTRY glBlendEquationSeparate (GLenum modeRGB, GLenum modeAlpha); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDrawBuffers (GLsizei n, const GLenum *bufs); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glStencilOpSeparate (GLenum face, GLenum sfail, GLenum dpfail, GLenum dppass); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glStencilFuncSeparate (GLenum face, GLenum func, GLint ref, GLuint mask); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glStencilMaskSeparate (GLenum face, GLuint mask); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glAttachShader (GLuint program, GLuint shader); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glBindAttribLocation (GLuint program, GLuint index, const GLchar *name); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glCompileShader (GLuint shader); +GLAPI GLuint APIENTRY glCreateProgram (void); +GLAPI GLuint APIENTRY glCreateShader (GLenum type); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDeleteProgram (GLuint program); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDeleteShader (GLuint shader); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDetachShader (GLuint program, GLuint shader); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDisableVertexAttribArray (GLuint index); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glEnableVertexAttribArray (GLuint index); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetActiveAttrib (GLuint program, GLuint index, GLsizei bufSize, GLsizei *length, GLint *size, GLenum *type, GLchar *name); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetActiveUniform (GLuint program, GLuint index, GLsizei bufSize, GLsizei *length, GLint *size, GLenum *type, GLchar *name); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetAttachedShaders (GLuint program, GLsizei maxCount, GLsizei *count, GLuint *shaders); +GLAPI GLint APIENTRY glGetAttribLocation (GLuint program, const GLchar *name); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetProgramiv (GLuint program, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetProgramInfoLog (GLuint program, GLsizei bufSize, GLsizei *length, GLchar *infoLog); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetShaderiv (GLuint shader, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetShaderInfoLog (GLuint shader, GLsizei bufSize, GLsizei *length, GLchar *infoLog); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetShaderSource (GLuint shader, GLsizei bufSize, GLsizei *length, GLchar *source); +GLAPI GLint APIENTRY glGetUniformLocation (GLuint program, const GLchar *name); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetUniformfv (GLuint program, GLint location, GLfloat *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetUniformiv (GLuint program, GLint location, GLint *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetVertexAttribdv (GLuint index, GLenum pname, GLdouble *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetVertexAttribfv (GLuint index, GLenum pname, GLfloat *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetVertexAttribiv (GLuint index, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetVertexAttribPointerv (GLuint index, GLenum pname, void **pointer); +GLAPI GLboolean APIENTRY glIsProgram (GLuint program); +GLAPI GLboolean APIENTRY glIsShader (GLuint shader); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glLinkProgram (GLuint program); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glShaderSource (GLuint shader, GLsizei count, const GLchar *const*string, const GLint *length); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glUseProgram (GLuint program); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glUniform1f (GLint location, GLfloat v0); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glUniform2f (GLint location, GLfloat v0, GLfloat v1); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glUniform3f (GLint location, GLfloat v0, GLfloat v1, GLfloat v2); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glUniform4f (GLint location, GLfloat v0, GLfloat v1, GLfloat v2, GLfloat v3); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glUniform1i (GLint location, GLint v0); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glUniform2i (GLint location, GLint v0, GLint v1); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glUniform3i (GLint location, GLint v0, GLint v1, GLint v2); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glUniform4i (GLint location, GLint v0, GLint v1, GLint v2, GLint v3); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glUniform1fv (GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLfloat *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glUniform2fv (GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLfloat *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glUniform3fv (GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLfloat *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glUniform4fv (GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLfloat *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glUniform1iv (GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLint *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glUniform2iv (GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLint *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glUniform3iv (GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLint *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glUniform4iv (GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLint *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glUniformMatrix2fv (GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLfloat *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glUniformMatrix3fv (GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLfloat *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glUniformMatrix4fv (GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLfloat *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glValidateProgram (GLuint program); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttrib1d (GLuint index, GLdouble x); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttrib1dv (GLuint index, const GLdouble *v); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttrib1f (GLuint index, GLfloat x); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttrib1fv (GLuint index, const GLfloat *v); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttrib1s (GLuint index, GLshort x); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttrib1sv (GLuint index, const GLshort *v); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttrib2d (GLuint index, GLdouble x, GLdouble y); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttrib2dv (GLuint index, const GLdouble *v); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttrib2f (GLuint index, GLfloat x, GLfloat y); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttrib2fv (GLuint index, const GLfloat *v); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttrib2s (GLuint index, GLshort x, GLshort y); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttrib2sv (GLuint index, const GLshort *v); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttrib3d (GLuint index, GLdouble x, GLdouble y, GLdouble z); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttrib3dv (GLuint index, const GLdouble *v); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttrib3f (GLuint index, GLfloat x, GLfloat y, GLfloat z); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttrib3fv (GLuint index, const GLfloat *v); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttrib3s (GLuint index, GLshort x, GLshort y, GLshort z); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttrib3sv (GLuint index, const GLshort *v); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttrib4Nbv (GLuint index, const GLbyte *v); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttrib4Niv (GLuint index, const GLint *v); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttrib4Nsv (GLuint index, const GLshort *v); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttrib4Nub (GLuint index, GLubyte x, GLubyte y, GLubyte z, GLubyte w); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttrib4Nubv (GLuint index, const GLubyte *v); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttrib4Nuiv (GLuint index, const GLuint *v); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttrib4Nusv (GLuint index, const GLushort *v); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttrib4bv (GLuint index, const GLbyte *v); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttrib4d (GLuint index, GLdouble x, GLdouble y, GLdouble z, GLdouble w); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttrib4dv (GLuint index, const GLdouble *v); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttrib4f (GLuint index, GLfloat x, GLfloat y, GLfloat z, GLfloat w); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttrib4fv (GLuint index, const GLfloat *v); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttrib4iv (GLuint index, const GLint *v); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttrib4s (GLuint index, GLshort x, GLshort y, GLshort z, GLshort w); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttrib4sv (GLuint index, const GLshort *v); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttrib4ubv (GLuint index, const GLubyte *v); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttrib4uiv (GLuint index, const GLuint *v); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttrib4usv (GLuint index, const GLushort *v); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttribPointer (GLuint index, GLint size, GLenum type, GLboolean normalized, GLsizei stride, const void *pointer); +#endif +#endif /* GL_VERSION_2_0 */ + +#ifndef GL_VERSION_2_1 +#define GL_VERSION_2_1 1 +#define GL_PIXEL_PACK_BUFFER 0x88EB +#define GL_PIXEL_UNPACK_BUFFER 0x88EC +#define GL_PIXEL_PACK_BUFFER_BINDING 0x88ED +#define GL_PIXEL_UNPACK_BUFFER_BINDING 0x88EF +#define GL_FLOAT_MAT2x3 0x8B65 +#define GL_FLOAT_MAT2x4 0x8B66 +#define GL_FLOAT_MAT3x2 0x8B67 +#define GL_FLOAT_MAT3x4 0x8B68 +#define GL_FLOAT_MAT4x2 0x8B69 +#define GL_FLOAT_MAT4x3 0x8B6A +#define GL_SRGB 0x8C40 +#define GL_SRGB8 0x8C41 +#define GL_SRGB_ALPHA 0x8C42 +#define GL_SRGB8_ALPHA8 0x8C43 +#define GL_COMPRESSED_SRGB 0x8C48 +#define GL_COMPRESSED_SRGB_ALPHA 0x8C49 +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX2X3FVPROC) (GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLfloat *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX3X2FVPROC) (GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLfloat *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX2X4FVPROC) (GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLfloat *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX4X2FVPROC) (GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLfloat *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX3X4FVPROC) (GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLfloat *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX4X3FVPROC) (GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLfloat *value); +#ifdef GL_GLEXT_PROTOTYPES +GLAPI void APIENTRY glUniformMatrix2x3fv (GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLfloat *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glUniformMatrix3x2fv (GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLfloat *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glUniformMatrix2x4fv (GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLfloat *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glUniformMatrix4x2fv (GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLfloat *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glUniformMatrix3x4fv (GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLfloat *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glUniformMatrix4x3fv (GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLfloat *value); +#endif +#endif /* GL_VERSION_2_1 */ + +#ifndef GL_VERSION_3_0 +#define GL_VERSION_3_0 1 +typedef unsigned short GLhalf; +#define GL_COMPARE_REF_TO_TEXTURE 0x884E +#define GL_CLIP_DISTANCE0 0x3000 +#define GL_CLIP_DISTANCE1 0x3001 +#define GL_CLIP_DISTANCE2 0x3002 +#define GL_CLIP_DISTANCE3 0x3003 +#define GL_CLIP_DISTANCE4 0x3004 +#define GL_CLIP_DISTANCE5 0x3005 +#define GL_CLIP_DISTANCE6 0x3006 +#define GL_CLIP_DISTANCE7 0x3007 +#define GL_MAX_CLIP_DISTANCES 0x0D32 +#define GL_MAJOR_VERSION 0x821B +#define GL_MINOR_VERSION 0x821C +#define GL_NUM_EXTENSIONS 0x821D +#define GL_CONTEXT_FLAGS 0x821E +#define GL_COMPRESSED_RED 0x8225 +#define GL_COMPRESSED_RG 0x8226 +#define GL_CONTEXT_FLAG_FORWARD_COMPATIBLE_BIT 0x00000001 +#define GL_RGBA32F 0x8814 +#define GL_RGB32F 0x8815 +#define GL_RGBA16F 0x881A +#define GL_RGB16F 0x881B +#define GL_VERTEX_ATTRIB_ARRAY_INTEGER 0x88FD +#define GL_MAX_ARRAY_TEXTURE_LAYERS 0x88FF +#define GL_MIN_PROGRAM_TEXEL_OFFSET 0x8904 +#define GL_MAX_PROGRAM_TEXEL_OFFSET 0x8905 +#define GL_CLAMP_READ_COLOR 0x891C +#define GL_FIXED_ONLY 0x891D +#define GL_MAX_VARYING_COMPONENTS 0x8B4B +#define GL_TEXTURE_1D_ARRAY 0x8C18 +#define GL_PROXY_TEXTURE_1D_ARRAY 0x8C19 +#define GL_TEXTURE_2D_ARRAY 0x8C1A +#define GL_PROXY_TEXTURE_2D_ARRAY 0x8C1B +#define GL_TEXTURE_BINDING_1D_ARRAY 0x8C1C +#define GL_TEXTURE_BINDING_2D_ARRAY 0x8C1D +#define GL_R11F_G11F_B10F 0x8C3A +#define GL_UNSIGNED_INT_10F_11F_11F_REV 0x8C3B +#define GL_RGB9_E5 0x8C3D +#define GL_UNSIGNED_INT_5_9_9_9_REV 0x8C3E +#define GL_TEXTURE_SHARED_SIZE 0x8C3F +#define GL_TRANSFORM_FEEDBACK_VARYING_MAX_LENGTH 0x8C76 +#define GL_TRANSFORM_FEEDBACK_BUFFER_MODE 0x8C7F +#define GL_MAX_TRANSFORM_FEEDBACK_SEPARATE_COMPONENTS 0x8C80 +#define GL_TRANSFORM_FEEDBACK_VARYINGS 0x8C83 +#define GL_TRANSFORM_FEEDBACK_BUFFER_START 0x8C84 +#define GL_TRANSFORM_FEEDBACK_BUFFER_SIZE 0x8C85 +#define GL_PRIMITIVES_GENERATED 0x8C87 +#define GL_TRANSFORM_FEEDBACK_PRIMITIVES_WRITTEN 0x8C88 +#define GL_RASTERIZER_DISCARD 0x8C89 +#define GL_MAX_TRANSFORM_FEEDBACK_INTERLEAVED_COMPONENTS 0x8C8A +#define GL_MAX_TRANSFORM_FEEDBACK_SEPARATE_ATTRIBS 0x8C8B +#define GL_INTERLEAVED_ATTRIBS 0x8C8C +#define GL_SEPARATE_ATTRIBS 0x8C8D +#define GL_TRANSFORM_FEEDBACK_BUFFER 0x8C8E +#define GL_TRANSFORM_FEEDBACK_BUFFER_BINDING 0x8C8F +#define GL_RGBA32UI 0x8D70 +#define GL_RGB32UI 0x8D71 +#define GL_RGBA16UI 0x8D76 +#define GL_RGB16UI 0x8D77 +#define GL_RGBA8UI 0x8D7C +#define GL_RGB8UI 0x8D7D +#define GL_RGBA32I 0x8D82 +#define GL_RGB32I 0x8D83 +#define GL_RGBA16I 0x8D88 +#define GL_RGB16I 0x8D89 +#define GL_RGBA8I 0x8D8E +#define GL_RGB8I 0x8D8F +#define GL_RED_INTEGER 0x8D94 +#define GL_GREEN_INTEGER 0x8D95 +#define GL_BLUE_INTEGER 0x8D96 +#define GL_RGB_INTEGER 0x8D98 +#define GL_RGBA_INTEGER 0x8D99 +#define GL_BGR_INTEGER 0x8D9A +#define GL_BGRA_INTEGER 0x8D9B +#define GL_SAMPLER_1D_ARRAY 0x8DC0 +#define GL_SAMPLER_2D_ARRAY 0x8DC1 +#define GL_SAMPLER_1D_ARRAY_SHADOW 0x8DC3 +#define GL_SAMPLER_2D_ARRAY_SHADOW 0x8DC4 +#define GL_SAMPLER_CUBE_SHADOW 0x8DC5 +#define GL_UNSIGNED_INT_VEC2 0x8DC6 +#define GL_UNSIGNED_INT_VEC3 0x8DC7 +#define GL_UNSIGNED_INT_VEC4 0x8DC8 +#define GL_INT_SAMPLER_1D 0x8DC9 +#define GL_INT_SAMPLER_2D 0x8DCA +#define GL_INT_SAMPLER_3D 0x8DCB +#define GL_INT_SAMPLER_CUBE 0x8DCC +#define GL_INT_SAMPLER_1D_ARRAY 0x8DCE +#define GL_INT_SAMPLER_2D_ARRAY 0x8DCF +#define GL_UNSIGNED_INT_SAMPLER_1D 0x8DD1 +#define GL_UNSIGNED_INT_SAMPLER_2D 0x8DD2 +#define GL_UNSIGNED_INT_SAMPLER_3D 0x8DD3 +#define GL_UNSIGNED_INT_SAMPLER_CUBE 0x8DD4 +#define GL_UNSIGNED_INT_SAMPLER_1D_ARRAY 0x8DD6 +#define GL_UNSIGNED_INT_SAMPLER_2D_ARRAY 0x8DD7 +#define GL_QUERY_WAIT 0x8E13 +#define GL_QUERY_NO_WAIT 0x8E14 +#define GL_QUERY_BY_REGION_WAIT 0x8E15 +#define GL_QUERY_BY_REGION_NO_WAIT 0x8E16 +#define GL_BUFFER_ACCESS_FLAGS 0x911F +#define GL_BUFFER_MAP_LENGTH 0x9120 +#define GL_BUFFER_MAP_OFFSET 0x9121 +#define GL_DEPTH_COMPONENT32F 0x8CAC +#define GL_DEPTH32F_STENCIL8 0x8CAD +#define GL_FLOAT_32_UNSIGNED_INT_24_8_REV 0x8DAD +#define GL_INVALID_FRAMEBUFFER_OPERATION 0x0506 +#define GL_FRAMEBUFFER_ATTACHMENT_COLOR_ENCODING 0x8210 +#define GL_FRAMEBUFFER_ATTACHMENT_COMPONENT_TYPE 0x8211 +#define GL_FRAMEBUFFER_ATTACHMENT_RED_SIZE 0x8212 +#define GL_FRAMEBUFFER_ATTACHMENT_GREEN_SIZE 0x8213 +#define GL_FRAMEBUFFER_ATTACHMENT_BLUE_SIZE 0x8214 +#define GL_FRAMEBUFFER_ATTACHMENT_ALPHA_SIZE 0x8215 +#define GL_FRAMEBUFFER_ATTACHMENT_DEPTH_SIZE 0x8216 +#define GL_FRAMEBUFFER_ATTACHMENT_STENCIL_SIZE 0x8217 +#define GL_FRAMEBUFFER_DEFAULT 0x8218 +#define GL_FRAMEBUFFER_UNDEFINED 0x8219 +#define GL_DEPTH_STENCIL_ATTACHMENT 0x821A +#define GL_MAX_RENDERBUFFER_SIZE 0x84E8 +#define GL_DEPTH_STENCIL 0x84F9 +#define GL_UNSIGNED_INT_24_8 0x84FA +#define GL_DEPTH24_STENCIL8 0x88F0 +#define GL_TEXTURE_STENCIL_SIZE 0x88F1 +#define GL_TEXTURE_RED_TYPE 0x8C10 +#define GL_TEXTURE_GREEN_TYPE 0x8C11 +#define GL_TEXTURE_BLUE_TYPE 0x8C12 +#define GL_TEXTURE_ALPHA_TYPE 0x8C13 +#define GL_TEXTURE_DEPTH_TYPE 0x8C16 +#define GL_UNSIGNED_NORMALIZED 0x8C17 +#define GL_FRAMEBUFFER_BINDING 0x8CA6 +#define GL_DRAW_FRAMEBUFFER_BINDING 0x8CA6 +#define GL_RENDERBUFFER_BINDING 0x8CA7 +#define GL_READ_FRAMEBUFFER 0x8CA8 +#define GL_DRAW_FRAMEBUFFER 0x8CA9 +#define GL_READ_FRAMEBUFFER_BINDING 0x8CAA +#define GL_RENDERBUFFER_SAMPLES 0x8CAB +#define GL_FRAMEBUFFER_ATTACHMENT_OBJECT_TYPE 0x8CD0 +#define GL_FRAMEBUFFER_ATTACHMENT_OBJECT_NAME 0x8CD1 +#define GL_FRAMEBUFFER_ATTACHMENT_TEXTURE_LEVEL 0x8CD2 +#define GL_FRAMEBUFFER_ATTACHMENT_TEXTURE_CUBE_MAP_FACE 0x8CD3 +#define GL_FRAMEBUFFER_ATTACHMENT_TEXTURE_LAYER 0x8CD4 +#define GL_FRAMEBUFFER_COMPLETE 0x8CD5 +#define GL_FRAMEBUFFER_INCOMPLETE_ATTACHMENT 0x8CD6 +#define GL_FRAMEBUFFER_INCOMPLETE_MISSING_ATTACHMENT 0x8CD7 +#define GL_FRAMEBUFFER_INCOMPLETE_DRAW_BUFFER 0x8CDB +#define GL_FRAMEBUFFER_INCOMPLETE_READ_BUFFER 0x8CDC +#define GL_FRAMEBUFFER_UNSUPPORTED 0x8CDD +#define GL_MAX_COLOR_ATTACHMENTS 0x8CDF +#define GL_COLOR_ATTACHMENT0 0x8CE0 +#define GL_COLOR_ATTACHMENT1 0x8CE1 +#define GL_COLOR_ATTACHMENT2 0x8CE2 +#define GL_COLOR_ATTACHMENT3 0x8CE3 +#define GL_COLOR_ATTACHMENT4 0x8CE4 +#define GL_COLOR_ATTACHMENT5 0x8CE5 +#define GL_COLOR_ATTACHMENT6 0x8CE6 +#define GL_COLOR_ATTACHMENT7 0x8CE7 +#define GL_COLOR_ATTACHMENT8 0x8CE8 +#define GL_COLOR_ATTACHMENT9 0x8CE9 +#define GL_COLOR_ATTACHMENT10 0x8CEA +#define GL_COLOR_ATTACHMENT11 0x8CEB +#define GL_COLOR_ATTACHMENT12 0x8CEC +#define GL_COLOR_ATTACHMENT13 0x8CED +#define GL_COLOR_ATTACHMENT14 0x8CEE +#define GL_COLOR_ATTACHMENT15 0x8CEF +#define GL_COLOR_ATTACHMENT16 0x8CF0 +#define GL_COLOR_ATTACHMENT17 0x8CF1 +#define GL_COLOR_ATTACHMENT18 0x8CF2 +#define GL_COLOR_ATTACHMENT19 0x8CF3 +#define GL_COLOR_ATTACHMENT20 0x8CF4 +#define GL_COLOR_ATTACHMENT21 0x8CF5 +#define GL_COLOR_ATTACHMENT22 0x8CF6 +#define GL_COLOR_ATTACHMENT23 0x8CF7 +#define GL_COLOR_ATTACHMENT24 0x8CF8 +#define GL_COLOR_ATTACHMENT25 0x8CF9 +#define GL_COLOR_ATTACHMENT26 0x8CFA +#define GL_COLOR_ATTACHMENT27 0x8CFB +#define GL_COLOR_ATTACHMENT28 0x8CFC +#define GL_COLOR_ATTACHMENT29 0x8CFD +#define GL_COLOR_ATTACHMENT30 0x8CFE +#define GL_COLOR_ATTACHMENT31 0x8CFF +#define GL_DEPTH_ATTACHMENT 0x8D00 +#define GL_STENCIL_ATTACHMENT 0x8D20 +#define GL_FRAMEBUFFER 0x8D40 +#define GL_RENDERBUFFER 0x8D41 +#define GL_RENDERBUFFER_WIDTH 0x8D42 +#define GL_RENDERBUFFER_HEIGHT 0x8D43 +#define GL_RENDERBUFFER_INTERNAL_FORMAT 0x8D44 +#define GL_STENCIL_INDEX1 0x8D46 +#define GL_STENCIL_INDEX4 0x8D47 +#define GL_STENCIL_INDEX8 0x8D48 +#define GL_STENCIL_INDEX16 0x8D49 +#define GL_RENDERBUFFER_RED_SIZE 0x8D50 +#define GL_RENDERBUFFER_GREEN_SIZE 0x8D51 +#define GL_RENDERBUFFER_BLUE_SIZE 0x8D52 +#define GL_RENDERBUFFER_ALPHA_SIZE 0x8D53 +#define GL_RENDERBUFFER_DEPTH_SIZE 0x8D54 +#define GL_RENDERBUFFER_STENCIL_SIZE 0x8D55 +#define GL_FRAMEBUFFER_INCOMPLETE_MULTISAMPLE 0x8D56 +#define GL_MAX_SAMPLES 0x8D57 +#define GL_FRAMEBUFFER_SRGB 0x8DB9 +#define GL_HALF_FLOAT 0x140B +#define GL_MAP_READ_BIT 0x0001 +#define GL_MAP_WRITE_BIT 0x0002 +#define GL_MAP_INVALIDATE_RANGE_BIT 0x0004 +#define GL_MAP_INVALIDATE_BUFFER_BIT 0x0008 +#define GL_MAP_FLUSH_EXPLICIT_BIT 0x0010 +#define GL_MAP_UNSYNCHRONIZED_BIT 0x0020 +#define GL_COMPRESSED_RED_RGTC1 0x8DBB +#define GL_COMPRESSED_SIGNED_RED_RGTC1 0x8DBC +#define GL_COMPRESSED_RG_RGTC2 0x8DBD +#define GL_COMPRESSED_SIGNED_RG_RGTC2 0x8DBE +#define GL_RG 0x8227 +#define GL_RG_INTEGER 0x8228 +#define GL_R8 0x8229 +#define GL_R16 0x822A +#define GL_RG8 0x822B +#define GL_RG16 0x822C +#define GL_R16F 0x822D +#define GL_R32F 0x822E +#define GL_RG16F 0x822F +#define GL_RG32F 0x8230 +#define GL_R8I 0x8231 +#define GL_R8UI 0x8232 +#define GL_R16I 0x8233 +#define GL_R16UI 0x8234 +#define GL_R32I 0x8235 +#define GL_R32UI 0x8236 +#define GL_RG8I 0x8237 +#define GL_RG8UI 0x8238 +#define GL_RG16I 0x8239 +#define GL_RG16UI 0x823A +#define GL_RG32I 0x823B +#define GL_RG32UI 0x823C +#define GL_VERTEX_ARRAY_BINDING 0x85B5 +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLCOLORMASKIPROC) (GLuint index, GLboolean r, GLboolean g, GLboolean b, GLboolean a); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETBOOLEANI_VPROC) (GLenum target, GLuint index, GLboolean *data); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETINTEGERI_VPROC) (GLenum target, GLuint index, GLint *data); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLENABLEIPROC) (GLenum target, GLuint index); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDISABLEIPROC) (GLenum target, GLuint index); +typedef GLboolean (APIENTRYP PFNGLISENABLEDIPROC) (GLenum target, GLuint index); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLBEGINTRANSFORMFEEDBACKPROC) (GLenum primitiveMode); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLENDTRANSFORMFEEDBACKPROC) (void); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLBINDBUFFERRANGEPROC) (GLenum target, GLuint index, GLuint buffer, GLintptr offset, GLsizeiptr size); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLBINDBUFFERBASEPROC) (GLenum target, GLuint index, GLuint buffer); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLTRANSFORMFEEDBACKVARYINGSPROC) (GLuint program, GLsizei count, const GLchar *const*varyings, GLenum bufferMode); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETTRANSFORMFEEDBACKVARYINGPROC) (GLuint program, GLuint index, GLsizei bufSize, GLsizei *length, GLsizei *size, GLenum *type, GLchar *name); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLCLAMPCOLORPROC) (GLenum target, GLenum clamp); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLBEGINCONDITIONALRENDERPROC) (GLuint id, GLenum mode); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLENDCONDITIONALRENDERPROC) (void); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBIPOINTERPROC) (GLuint index, GLint size, GLenum type, GLsizei stride, const void *pointer); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETVERTEXATTRIBIIVPROC) (GLuint index, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETVERTEXATTRIBIUIVPROC) (GLuint index, GLenum pname, GLuint *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI1IPROC) (GLuint index, GLint x); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI2IPROC) (GLuint index, GLint x, GLint y); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI3IPROC) (GLuint index, GLint x, GLint y, GLint z); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI4IPROC) (GLuint index, GLint x, GLint y, GLint z, GLint w); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI1UIPROC) (GLuint index, GLuint x); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI2UIPROC) (GLuint index, GLuint x, GLuint y); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI3UIPROC) (GLuint index, GLuint x, GLuint y, GLuint z); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI4UIPROC) (GLuint index, GLuint x, GLuint y, GLuint z, GLuint w); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI1IVPROC) (GLuint index, const GLint *v); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI2IVPROC) (GLuint index, const GLint *v); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI3IVPROC) (GLuint index, const GLint *v); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI4IVPROC) (GLuint index, const GLint *v); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI1UIVPROC) (GLuint index, const GLuint *v); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI2UIVPROC) (GLuint index, const GLuint *v); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI3UIVPROC) (GLuint index, const GLuint *v); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI4UIVPROC) (GLuint index, const GLuint *v); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI4BVPROC) (GLuint index, const GLbyte *v); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI4SVPROC) (GLuint index, const GLshort *v); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI4UBVPROC) (GLuint index, const GLubyte *v); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI4USVPROC) (GLuint index, const GLushort *v); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETUNIFORMUIVPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLuint *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLBINDFRAGDATALOCATIONPROC) (GLuint program, GLuint color, const GLchar *name); +typedef GLint (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETFRAGDATALOCATIONPROC) (GLuint program, const GLchar *name); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLUNIFORM1UIPROC) (GLint location, GLuint v0); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLUNIFORM2UIPROC) (GLint location, GLuint v0, GLuint v1); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLUNIFORM3UIPROC) (GLint location, GLuint v0, GLuint v1, GLuint v2); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLUNIFORM4UIPROC) (GLint location, GLuint v0, GLuint v1, GLuint v2, GLuint v3); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLUNIFORM1UIVPROC) (GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLuint *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLUNIFORM2UIVPROC) (GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLuint *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLUNIFORM3UIVPROC) (GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLuint *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLUNIFORM4UIVPROC) (GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLuint *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLTEXPARAMETERIIVPROC) (GLenum target, GLenum pname, const GLint *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLTEXPARAMETERIUIVPROC) (GLenum target, GLenum pname, const GLuint *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETTEXPARAMETERIIVPROC) (GLenum target, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETTEXPARAMETERIUIVPROC) (GLenum target, GLenum pname, GLuint *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLCLEARBUFFERIVPROC) (GLenum buffer, GLint drawbuffer, const GLint *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLCLEARBUFFERUIVPROC) (GLenum buffer, GLint drawbuffer, const GLuint *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLCLEARBUFFERFVPROC) (GLenum buffer, GLint drawbuffer, const GLfloat *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLCLEARBUFFERFIPROC) (GLenum buffer, GLint drawbuffer, GLfloat depth, GLint stencil); +typedef const GLubyte *(APIENTRYP PFNGLGETSTRINGIPROC) (GLenum name, GLuint index); +typedef GLboolean (APIENTRYP PFNGLISRENDERBUFFERPROC) (GLuint renderbuffer); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLBINDRENDERBUFFERPROC) (GLenum target, GLuint renderbuffer); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDELETERENDERBUFFERSPROC) (GLsizei n, const GLuint *renderbuffers); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGENRENDERBUFFERSPROC) (GLsizei n, GLuint *renderbuffers); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLRENDERBUFFERSTORAGEPROC) (GLenum target, GLenum internalformat, GLsizei width, GLsizei height); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETRENDERBUFFERPARAMETERIVPROC) (GLenum target, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +typedef GLboolean (APIENTRYP PFNGLISFRAMEBUFFERPROC) (GLuint framebuffer); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLBINDFRAMEBUFFERPROC) (GLenum target, GLuint framebuffer); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDELETEFRAMEBUFFERSPROC) (GLsizei n, const GLuint *framebuffers); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGENFRAMEBUFFERSPROC) (GLsizei n, GLuint *framebuffers); +typedef GLenum (APIENTRYP PFNGLCHECKFRAMEBUFFERSTATUSPROC) (GLenum target); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLFRAMEBUFFERTEXTURE1DPROC) (GLenum target, GLenum attachment, GLenum textarget, GLuint texture, GLint level); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLFRAMEBUFFERTEXTURE2DPROC) (GLenum target, GLenum attachment, GLenum textarget, GLuint texture, GLint level); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLFRAMEBUFFERTEXTURE3DPROC) (GLenum target, GLenum attachment, GLenum textarget, GLuint texture, GLint level, GLint zoffset); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLFRAMEBUFFERRENDERBUFFERPROC) (GLenum target, GLenum attachment, GLenum renderbuffertarget, GLuint renderbuffer); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETFRAMEBUFFERATTACHMENTPARAMETERIVPROC) (GLenum target, GLenum attachment, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGENERATEMIPMAPPROC) (GLenum target); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLBLITFRAMEBUFFERPROC) (GLint srcX0, GLint srcY0, GLint srcX1, GLint srcY1, GLint dstX0, GLint dstY0, GLint dstX1, GLint dstY1, GLbitfield mask, GLenum filter); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLRENDERBUFFERSTORAGEMULTISAMPLEPROC) (GLenum target, GLsizei samples, GLenum internalformat, GLsizei width, GLsizei height); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLFRAMEBUFFERTEXTURELAYERPROC) (GLenum target, GLenum attachment, GLuint texture, GLint level, GLint layer); +typedef void *(APIENTRYP PFNGLMAPBUFFERRANGEPROC) (GLenum target, GLintptr offset, GLsizeiptr length, GLbitfield access); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLFLUSHMAPPEDBUFFERRANGEPROC) (GLenum target, GLintptr offset, GLsizeiptr length); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLBINDVERTEXARRAYPROC) (GLuint array); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDELETEVERTEXARRAYSPROC) (GLsizei n, const GLuint *arrays); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGENVERTEXARRAYSPROC) (GLsizei n, GLuint *arrays); +typedef GLboolean (APIENTRYP PFNGLISVERTEXARRAYPROC) (GLuint array); +#ifdef GL_GLEXT_PROTOTYPES +GLAPI void APIENTRY glColorMaski (GLuint index, GLboolean r, GLboolean g, GLboolean b, GLboolean a); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetBooleani_v (GLenum target, GLuint index, GLboolean *data); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetIntegeri_v (GLenum target, GLuint index, GLint *data); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glEnablei (GLenum target, GLuint index); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDisablei (GLenum target, GLuint index); +GLAPI GLboolean APIENTRY glIsEnabledi (GLenum target, GLuint index); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glBeginTransformFeedback (GLenum primitiveMode); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glEndTransformFeedback (void); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glBindBufferRange (GLenum target, GLuint index, GLuint buffer, GLintptr offset, GLsizeiptr size); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glBindBufferBase (GLenum target, GLuint index, GLuint buffer); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glTransformFeedbackVaryings (GLuint program, GLsizei count, const GLchar *const*varyings, GLenum bufferMode); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetTransformFeedbackVarying (GLuint program, GLuint index, GLsizei bufSize, GLsizei *length, GLsizei *size, GLenum *type, GLchar *name); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glClampColor (GLenum target, GLenum clamp); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glBeginConditionalRender (GLuint id, GLenum mode); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glEndConditionalRender (void); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttribIPointer (GLuint index, GLint size, GLenum type, GLsizei stride, const void *pointer); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetVertexAttribIiv (GLuint index, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetVertexAttribIuiv (GLuint index, GLenum pname, GLuint *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttribI1i (GLuint index, GLint x); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttribI2i (GLuint index, GLint x, GLint y); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttribI3i (GLuint index, GLint x, GLint y, GLint z); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttribI4i (GLuint index, GLint x, GLint y, GLint z, GLint w); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttribI1ui (GLuint index, GLuint x); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttribI2ui (GLuint index, GLuint x, GLuint y); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttribI3ui (GLuint index, GLuint x, GLuint y, GLuint z); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttribI4ui (GLuint index, GLuint x, GLuint y, GLuint z, GLuint w); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttribI1iv (GLuint index, const GLint *v); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttribI2iv (GLuint index, const GLint *v); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttribI3iv (GLuint index, const GLint *v); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttribI4iv (GLuint index, const GLint *v); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttribI1uiv (GLuint index, const GLuint *v); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttribI2uiv (GLuint index, const GLuint *v); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttribI3uiv (GLuint index, const GLuint *v); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttribI4uiv (GLuint index, const GLuint *v); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttribI4bv (GLuint index, const GLbyte *v); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttribI4sv (GLuint index, const GLshort *v); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttribI4ubv (GLuint index, const GLubyte *v); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttribI4usv (GLuint index, const GLushort *v); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetUniformuiv (GLuint program, GLint location, GLuint *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glBindFragDataLocation (GLuint program, GLuint color, const GLchar *name); +GLAPI GLint APIENTRY glGetFragDataLocation (GLuint program, const GLchar *name); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glUniform1ui (GLint location, GLuint v0); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glUniform2ui (GLint location, GLuint v0, GLuint v1); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glUniform3ui (GLint location, GLuint v0, GLuint v1, GLuint v2); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glUniform4ui (GLint location, GLuint v0, GLuint v1, GLuint v2, GLuint v3); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glUniform1uiv (GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLuint *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glUniform2uiv (GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLuint *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glUniform3uiv (GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLuint *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glUniform4uiv (GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLuint *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glTexParameterIiv (GLenum target, GLenum pname, const GLint *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glTexParameterIuiv (GLenum target, GLenum pname, const GLuint *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetTexParameterIiv (GLenum target, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetTexParameterIuiv (GLenum target, GLenum pname, GLuint *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glClearBufferiv (GLenum buffer, GLint drawbuffer, const GLint *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glClearBufferuiv (GLenum buffer, GLint drawbuffer, const GLuint *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glClearBufferfv (GLenum buffer, GLint drawbuffer, const GLfloat *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glClearBufferfi (GLenum buffer, GLint drawbuffer, GLfloat depth, GLint stencil); +GLAPI const GLubyte *APIENTRY glGetStringi (GLenum name, GLuint index); +GLAPI GLboolean APIENTRY glIsRenderbuffer (GLuint renderbuffer); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glBindRenderbuffer (GLenum target, GLuint renderbuffer); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDeleteRenderbuffers (GLsizei n, const GLuint *renderbuffers); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGenRenderbuffers (GLsizei n, GLuint *renderbuffers); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glRenderbufferStorage (GLenum target, GLenum internalformat, GLsizei width, GLsizei height); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetRenderbufferParameteriv (GLenum target, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +GLAPI GLboolean APIENTRY glIsFramebuffer (GLuint framebuffer); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glBindFramebuffer (GLenum target, GLuint framebuffer); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDeleteFramebuffers (GLsizei n, const GLuint *framebuffers); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGenFramebuffers (GLsizei n, GLuint *framebuffers); +GLAPI GLenum APIENTRY glCheckFramebufferStatus (GLenum target); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glFramebufferTexture1D (GLenum target, GLenum attachment, GLenum textarget, GLuint texture, GLint level); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glFramebufferTexture2D (GLenum target, GLenum attachment, GLenum textarget, GLuint texture, GLint level); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glFramebufferTexture3D (GLenum target, GLenum attachment, GLenum textarget, GLuint texture, GLint level, GLint zoffset); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glFramebufferRenderbuffer (GLenum target, GLenum attachment, GLenum renderbuffertarget, GLuint renderbuffer); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetFramebufferAttachmentParameteriv (GLenum target, GLenum attachment, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGenerateMipmap (GLenum target); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glBlitFramebuffer (GLint srcX0, GLint srcY0, GLint srcX1, GLint srcY1, GLint dstX0, GLint dstY0, GLint dstX1, GLint dstY1, GLbitfield mask, GLenum filter); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glRenderbufferStorageMultisample (GLenum target, GLsizei samples, GLenum internalformat, GLsizei width, GLsizei height); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glFramebufferTextureLayer (GLenum target, GLenum attachment, GLuint texture, GLint level, GLint layer); +GLAPI void *APIENTRY glMapBufferRange (GLenum target, GLintptr offset, GLsizeiptr length, GLbitfield access); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glFlushMappedBufferRange (GLenum target, GLintptr offset, GLsizeiptr length); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glBindVertexArray (GLuint array); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDeleteVertexArrays (GLsizei n, const GLuint *arrays); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGenVertexArrays (GLsizei n, GLuint *arrays); +GLAPI GLboolean APIENTRY glIsVertexArray (GLuint array); +#endif +#endif /* GL_VERSION_3_0 */ + +#ifndef GL_VERSION_3_1 +#define GL_VERSION_3_1 1 +#define GL_SAMPLER_2D_RECT 0x8B63 +#define GL_SAMPLER_2D_RECT_SHADOW 0x8B64 +#define GL_SAMPLER_BUFFER 0x8DC2 +#define GL_INT_SAMPLER_2D_RECT 0x8DCD +#define GL_INT_SAMPLER_BUFFER 0x8DD0 +#define GL_UNSIGNED_INT_SAMPLER_2D_RECT 0x8DD5 +#define GL_UNSIGNED_INT_SAMPLER_BUFFER 0x8DD8 +#define GL_TEXTURE_BUFFER 0x8C2A +#define GL_MAX_TEXTURE_BUFFER_SIZE 0x8C2B +#define GL_TEXTURE_BINDING_BUFFER 0x8C2C +#define GL_TEXTURE_BUFFER_DATA_STORE_BINDING 0x8C2D +#define GL_TEXTURE_RECTANGLE 0x84F5 +#define GL_TEXTURE_BINDING_RECTANGLE 0x84F6 +#define GL_PROXY_TEXTURE_RECTANGLE 0x84F7 +#define GL_MAX_RECTANGLE_TEXTURE_SIZE 0x84F8 +#define GL_R8_SNORM 0x8F94 +#define GL_RG8_SNORM 0x8F95 +#define GL_RGB8_SNORM 0x8F96 +#define GL_RGBA8_SNORM 0x8F97 +#define GL_R16_SNORM 0x8F98 +#define GL_RG16_SNORM 0x8F99 +#define GL_RGB16_SNORM 0x8F9A +#define GL_RGBA16_SNORM 0x8F9B +#define GL_SIGNED_NORMALIZED 0x8F9C +#define GL_PRIMITIVE_RESTART 0x8F9D +#define GL_PRIMITIVE_RESTART_INDEX 0x8F9E +#define GL_COPY_READ_BUFFER 0x8F36 +#define GL_COPY_WRITE_BUFFER 0x8F37 +#define GL_UNIFORM_BUFFER 0x8A11 +#define GL_UNIFORM_BUFFER_BINDING 0x8A28 +#define GL_UNIFORM_BUFFER_START 0x8A29 +#define GL_UNIFORM_BUFFER_SIZE 0x8A2A +#define GL_MAX_VERTEX_UNIFORM_BLOCKS 0x8A2B +#define GL_MAX_GEOMETRY_UNIFORM_BLOCKS 0x8A2C +#define GL_MAX_FRAGMENT_UNIFORM_BLOCKS 0x8A2D +#define GL_MAX_COMBINED_UNIFORM_BLOCKS 0x8A2E +#define GL_MAX_UNIFORM_BUFFER_BINDINGS 0x8A2F +#define GL_MAX_UNIFORM_BLOCK_SIZE 0x8A30 +#define GL_MAX_COMBINED_VERTEX_UNIFORM_COMPONENTS 0x8A31 +#define GL_MAX_COMBINED_GEOMETRY_UNIFORM_COMPONENTS 0x8A32 +#define GL_MAX_COMBINED_FRAGMENT_UNIFORM_COMPONENTS 0x8A33 +#define GL_UNIFORM_BUFFER_OFFSET_ALIGNMENT 0x8A34 +#define GL_ACTIVE_UNIFORM_BLOCK_MAX_NAME_LENGTH 0x8A35 +#define GL_ACTIVE_UNIFORM_BLOCKS 0x8A36 +#define GL_UNIFORM_TYPE 0x8A37 +#define GL_UNIFORM_SIZE 0x8A38 +#define GL_UNIFORM_NAME_LENGTH 0x8A39 +#define GL_UNIFORM_BLOCK_INDEX 0x8A3A +#define GL_UNIFORM_OFFSET 0x8A3B +#define GL_UNIFORM_ARRAY_STRIDE 0x8A3C +#define GL_UNIFORM_MATRIX_STRIDE 0x8A3D +#define GL_UNIFORM_IS_ROW_MAJOR 0x8A3E +#define GL_UNIFORM_BLOCK_BINDING 0x8A3F +#define GL_UNIFORM_BLOCK_DATA_SIZE 0x8A40 +#define GL_UNIFORM_BLOCK_NAME_LENGTH 0x8A41 +#define GL_UNIFORM_BLOCK_ACTIVE_UNIFORMS 0x8A42 +#define GL_UNIFORM_BLOCK_ACTIVE_UNIFORM_INDICES 0x8A43 +#define GL_UNIFORM_BLOCK_REFERENCED_BY_VERTEX_SHADER 0x8A44 +#define GL_UNIFORM_BLOCK_REFERENCED_BY_GEOMETRY_SHADER 0x8A45 +#define GL_UNIFORM_BLOCK_REFERENCED_BY_FRAGMENT_SHADER 0x8A46 +#define GL_INVALID_INDEX 0xFFFFFFFFu +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDRAWARRAYSINSTANCEDPROC) (GLenum mode, GLint first, GLsizei count, GLsizei instancecount); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDRAWELEMENTSINSTANCEDPROC) (GLenum mode, GLsizei count, GLenum type, const void *indices, GLsizei instancecount); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLTEXBUFFERPROC) (GLenum target, GLenum internalformat, GLuint buffer); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPRIMITIVERESTARTINDEXPROC) (GLuint index); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLCOPYBUFFERSUBDATAPROC) (GLenum readTarget, GLenum writeTarget, GLintptr readOffset, GLintptr writeOffset, GLsizeiptr size); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETUNIFORMINDICESPROC) (GLuint program, GLsizei uniformCount, const GLchar *const*uniformNames, GLuint *uniformIndices); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETACTIVEUNIFORMSIVPROC) (GLuint program, GLsizei uniformCount, const GLuint *uniformIndices, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETACTIVEUNIFORMNAMEPROC) (GLuint program, GLuint uniformIndex, GLsizei bufSize, GLsizei *length, GLchar *uniformName); +typedef GLuint (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETUNIFORMBLOCKINDEXPROC) (GLuint program, const GLchar *uniformBlockName); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETACTIVEUNIFORMBLOCKIVPROC) (GLuint program, GLuint uniformBlockIndex, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETACTIVEUNIFORMBLOCKNAMEPROC) (GLuint program, GLuint uniformBlockIndex, GLsizei bufSize, GLsizei *length, GLchar *uniformBlockName); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLUNIFORMBLOCKBINDINGPROC) (GLuint program, GLuint uniformBlockIndex, GLuint uniformBlockBinding); +#ifdef GL_GLEXT_PROTOTYPES +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDrawArraysInstanced (GLenum mode, GLint first, GLsizei count, GLsizei instancecount); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDrawElementsInstanced (GLenum mode, GLsizei count, GLenum type, const void *indices, GLsizei instancecount); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glTexBuffer (GLenum target, GLenum internalformat, GLuint buffer); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glPrimitiveRestartIndex (GLuint index); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glCopyBufferSubData (GLenum readTarget, GLenum writeTarget, GLintptr readOffset, GLintptr writeOffset, GLsizeiptr size); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetUniformIndices (GLuint program, GLsizei uniformCount, const GLchar *const*uniformNames, GLuint *uniformIndices); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetActiveUniformsiv (GLuint program, GLsizei uniformCount, const GLuint *uniformIndices, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetActiveUniformName (GLuint program, GLuint uniformIndex, GLsizei bufSize, GLsizei *length, GLchar *uniformName); +GLAPI GLuint APIENTRY glGetUniformBlockIndex (GLuint program, const GLchar *uniformBlockName); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetActiveUniformBlockiv (GLuint program, GLuint uniformBlockIndex, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetActiveUniformBlockName (GLuint program, GLuint uniformBlockIndex, GLsizei bufSize, GLsizei *length, GLchar *uniformBlockName); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glUniformBlockBinding (GLuint program, GLuint uniformBlockIndex, GLuint uniformBlockBinding); +#endif +#endif /* GL_VERSION_3_1 */ + +#ifndef GL_VERSION_3_2 +#define GL_VERSION_3_2 1 +typedef struct __GLsync *GLsync; +#ifndef GLEXT_64_TYPES_DEFINED +/* This code block is duplicated in glxext.h, so must be protected */ +#define GLEXT_64_TYPES_DEFINED +/* Define int32_t, int64_t, and uint64_t types for UST/MSC */ +/* (as used in the GL_EXT_timer_query extension). */ +#if defined(__STDC_VERSION__) && __STDC_VERSION__ >= 199901L +#include +#elif defined(__sun__) || defined(__digital__) +#include +#if defined(__STDC__) +#if defined(__arch64__) || defined(_LP64) +typedef long int int64_t; +typedef unsigned long int uint64_t; +#else +typedef long long int int64_t; +typedef unsigned long long int uint64_t; +#endif /* __arch64__ */ +#endif /* __STDC__ */ +#elif defined( __VMS ) || defined(__sgi) +#include +#elif defined(__SCO__) || defined(__USLC__) +#include +#elif defined(__UNIXOS2__) || defined(__SOL64__) +typedef long int int32_t; +typedef long long int int64_t; +typedef unsigned long long int uint64_t; +#elif defined(_WIN32) && defined(__GNUC__) +#include +#elif defined(_WIN32) +typedef __int32 int32_t; +typedef __int64 int64_t; +typedef unsigned __int64 uint64_t; +#else +/* Fallback if nothing above works */ +#include +#endif +#endif +typedef uint64_t GLuint64; +typedef int64_t GLint64; +#define GL_CONTEXT_CORE_PROFILE_BIT 0x00000001 +#define GL_CONTEXT_COMPATIBILITY_PROFILE_BIT 0x00000002 +#define GL_LINES_ADJACENCY 0x000A +#define GL_LINE_STRIP_ADJACENCY 0x000B +#define GL_TRIANGLES_ADJACENCY 0x000C +#define GL_TRIANGLE_STRIP_ADJACENCY 0x000D +#define GL_PROGRAM_POINT_SIZE 0x8642 +#define GL_MAX_GEOMETRY_TEXTURE_IMAGE_UNITS 0x8C29 +#define GL_FRAMEBUFFER_ATTACHMENT_LAYERED 0x8DA7 +#define GL_FRAMEBUFFER_INCOMPLETE_LAYER_TARGETS 0x8DA8 +#define GL_GEOMETRY_SHADER 0x8DD9 +#define GL_GEOMETRY_VERTICES_OUT 0x8916 +#define GL_GEOMETRY_INPUT_TYPE 0x8917 +#define GL_GEOMETRY_OUTPUT_TYPE 0x8918 +#define GL_MAX_GEOMETRY_UNIFORM_COMPONENTS 0x8DDF +#define GL_MAX_GEOMETRY_OUTPUT_VERTICES 0x8DE0 +#define GL_MAX_GEOMETRY_TOTAL_OUTPUT_COMPONENTS 0x8DE1 +#define GL_MAX_VERTEX_OUTPUT_COMPONENTS 0x9122 +#define GL_MAX_GEOMETRY_INPUT_COMPONENTS 0x9123 +#define GL_MAX_GEOMETRY_OUTPUT_COMPONENTS 0x9124 +#define GL_MAX_FRAGMENT_INPUT_COMPONENTS 0x9125 +#define GL_CONTEXT_PROFILE_MASK 0x9126 +#define GL_DEPTH_CLAMP 0x864F +#define GL_QUADS_FOLLOW_PROVOKING_VERTEX_CONVENTION 0x8E4C +#define GL_FIRST_VERTEX_CONVENTION 0x8E4D +#define GL_LAST_VERTEX_CONVENTION 0x8E4E +#define GL_PROVOKING_VERTEX 0x8E4F +#define GL_TEXTURE_CUBE_MAP_SEAMLESS 0x884F +#define GL_MAX_SERVER_WAIT_TIMEOUT 0x9111 +#define GL_OBJECT_TYPE 0x9112 +#define GL_SYNC_CONDITION 0x9113 +#define GL_SYNC_STATUS 0x9114 +#define GL_SYNC_FLAGS 0x9115 +#define GL_SYNC_FENCE 0x9116 +#define GL_SYNC_GPU_COMMANDS_COMPLETE 0x9117 +#define GL_UNSIGNALED 0x9118 +#define GL_SIGNALED 0x9119 +#define GL_ALREADY_SIGNALED 0x911A +#define GL_TIMEOUT_EXPIRED 0x911B +#define GL_CONDITION_SATISFIED 0x911C +#define GL_WAIT_FAILED 0x911D +#define GL_TIMEOUT_IGNORED 0xFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFull +#define GL_SYNC_FLUSH_COMMANDS_BIT 0x00000001 +#define GL_SAMPLE_POSITION 0x8E50 +#define GL_SAMPLE_MASK 0x8E51 +#define GL_SAMPLE_MASK_VALUE 0x8E52 +#define GL_MAX_SAMPLE_MASK_WORDS 0x8E59 +#define GL_TEXTURE_2D_MULTISAMPLE 0x9100 +#define GL_PROXY_TEXTURE_2D_MULTISAMPLE 0x9101 +#define GL_TEXTURE_2D_MULTISAMPLE_ARRAY 0x9102 +#define GL_PROXY_TEXTURE_2D_MULTISAMPLE_ARRAY 0x9103 +#define GL_TEXTURE_BINDING_2D_MULTISAMPLE 0x9104 +#define GL_TEXTURE_BINDING_2D_MULTISAMPLE_ARRAY 0x9105 +#define GL_TEXTURE_SAMPLES 0x9106 +#define GL_TEXTURE_FIXED_SAMPLE_LOCATIONS 0x9107 +#define GL_SAMPLER_2D_MULTISAMPLE 0x9108 +#define GL_INT_SAMPLER_2D_MULTISAMPLE 0x9109 +#define GL_UNSIGNED_INT_SAMPLER_2D_MULTISAMPLE 0x910A +#define GL_SAMPLER_2D_MULTISAMPLE_ARRAY 0x910B +#define GL_INT_SAMPLER_2D_MULTISAMPLE_ARRAY 0x910C +#define GL_UNSIGNED_INT_SAMPLER_2D_MULTISAMPLE_ARRAY 0x910D +#define GL_MAX_COLOR_TEXTURE_SAMPLES 0x910E +#define GL_MAX_DEPTH_TEXTURE_SAMPLES 0x910F +#define GL_MAX_INTEGER_SAMPLES 0x9110 +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDRAWELEMENTSBASEVERTEXPROC) (GLenum mode, GLsizei count, GLenum type, const void *indices, GLint basevertex); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDRAWRANGEELEMENTSBASEVERTEXPROC) (GLenum mode, GLuint start, GLuint end, GLsizei count, GLenum type, const void *indices, GLint basevertex); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDRAWELEMENTSINSTANCEDBASEVERTEXPROC) (GLenum mode, GLsizei count, GLenum type, const void *indices, GLsizei instancecount, GLint basevertex); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLMULTIDRAWELEMENTSBASEVERTEXPROC) (GLenum mode, const GLsizei *count, GLenum type, const void *const*indices, GLsizei drawcount, const GLint *basevertex); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPROVOKINGVERTEXPROC) (GLenum mode); +typedef GLsync (APIENTRYP PFNGLFENCESYNCPROC) (GLenum condition, GLbitfield flags); +typedef GLboolean (APIENTRYP PFNGLISSYNCPROC) (GLsync sync); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDELETESYNCPROC) (GLsync sync); +typedef GLenum (APIENTRYP PFNGLCLIENTWAITSYNCPROC) (GLsync sync, GLbitfield flags, GLuint64 timeout); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLWAITSYNCPROC) (GLsync sync, GLbitfield flags, GLuint64 timeout); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETINTEGER64VPROC) (GLenum pname, GLint64 *data); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETSYNCIVPROC) (GLsync sync, GLenum pname, GLsizei bufSize, GLsizei *length, GLint *values); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETINTEGER64I_VPROC) (GLenum target, GLuint index, GLint64 *data); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETBUFFERPARAMETERI64VPROC) (GLenum target, GLenum pname, GLint64 *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLFRAMEBUFFERTEXTUREPROC) (GLenum target, GLenum attachment, GLuint texture, GLint level); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLTEXIMAGE2DMULTISAMPLEPROC) (GLenum target, GLsizei samples, GLenum internalformat, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLboolean fixedsamplelocations); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLTEXIMAGE3DMULTISAMPLEPROC) (GLenum target, GLsizei samples, GLenum internalformat, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLsizei depth, GLboolean fixedsamplelocations); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETMULTISAMPLEFVPROC) (GLenum pname, GLuint index, GLfloat *val); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLSAMPLEMASKIPROC) (GLuint maskNumber, GLbitfield mask); +#ifdef GL_GLEXT_PROTOTYPES +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDrawElementsBaseVertex (GLenum mode, GLsizei count, GLenum type, const void *indices, GLint basevertex); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDrawRangeElementsBaseVertex (GLenum mode, GLuint start, GLuint end, GLsizei count, GLenum type, const void *indices, GLint basevertex); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDrawElementsInstancedBaseVertex (GLenum mode, GLsizei count, GLenum type, const void *indices, GLsizei instancecount, GLint basevertex); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glMultiDrawElementsBaseVertex (GLenum mode, const GLsizei *count, GLenum type, const void *const*indices, GLsizei drawcount, const GLint *basevertex); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glProvokingVertex (GLenum mode); +GLAPI GLsync APIENTRY glFenceSync (GLenum condition, GLbitfield flags); +GLAPI GLboolean APIENTRY glIsSync (GLsync sync); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDeleteSync (GLsync sync); +GLAPI GLenum APIENTRY glClientWaitSync (GLsync sync, GLbitfield flags, GLuint64 timeout); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glWaitSync (GLsync sync, GLbitfield flags, GLuint64 timeout); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetInteger64v (GLenum pname, GLint64 *data); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetSynciv (GLsync sync, GLenum pname, GLsizei bufSize, GLsizei *length, GLint *values); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetInteger64i_v (GLenum target, GLuint index, GLint64 *data); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetBufferParameteri64v (GLenum target, GLenum pname, GLint64 *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glFramebufferTexture (GLenum target, GLenum attachment, GLuint texture, GLint level); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glTexImage2DMultisample (GLenum target, GLsizei samples, GLenum internalformat, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLboolean fixedsamplelocations); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glTexImage3DMultisample (GLenum target, GLsizei samples, GLenum internalformat, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLsizei depth, GLboolean fixedsamplelocations); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetMultisamplefv (GLenum pname, GLuint index, GLfloat *val); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glSampleMaski (GLuint maskNumber, GLbitfield mask); +#endif +#endif /* GL_VERSION_3_2 */ + +#ifndef GL_VERSION_3_3 +#define GL_VERSION_3_3 1 +#define GL_VERTEX_ATTRIB_ARRAY_DIVISOR 0x88FE +#define GL_SRC1_COLOR 0x88F9 +#define GL_ONE_MINUS_SRC1_COLOR 0x88FA +#define GL_ONE_MINUS_SRC1_ALPHA 0x88FB +#define GL_MAX_DUAL_SOURCE_DRAW_BUFFERS 0x88FC +#define GL_ANY_SAMPLES_PASSED 0x8C2F +#define GL_SAMPLER_BINDING 0x8919 +#define GL_RGB10_A2UI 0x906F +#define GL_TEXTURE_SWIZZLE_R 0x8E42 +#define GL_TEXTURE_SWIZZLE_G 0x8E43 +#define GL_TEXTURE_SWIZZLE_B 0x8E44 +#define GL_TEXTURE_SWIZZLE_A 0x8E45 +#define GL_TEXTURE_SWIZZLE_RGBA 0x8E46 +#define GL_TIME_ELAPSED 0x88BF +#define GL_TIMESTAMP 0x8E28 +#define GL_INT_2_10_10_10_REV 0x8D9F +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLBINDFRAGDATALOCATIONINDEXEDPROC) (GLuint program, GLuint colorNumber, GLuint index, const GLchar *name); +typedef GLint (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETFRAGDATAINDEXPROC) (GLuint program, const GLchar *name); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGENSAMPLERSPROC) (GLsizei count, GLuint *samplers); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDELETESAMPLERSPROC) (GLsizei count, const GLuint *samplers); +typedef GLboolean (APIENTRYP PFNGLISSAMPLERPROC) (GLuint sampler); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLBINDSAMPLERPROC) (GLuint unit, GLuint sampler); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLSAMPLERPARAMETERIPROC) (GLuint sampler, GLenum pname, GLint param); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLSAMPLERPARAMETERIVPROC) (GLuint sampler, GLenum pname, const GLint *param); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLSAMPLERPARAMETERFPROC) (GLuint sampler, GLenum pname, GLfloat param); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLSAMPLERPARAMETERFVPROC) (GLuint sampler, GLenum pname, const GLfloat *param); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLSAMPLERPARAMETERIIVPROC) (GLuint sampler, GLenum pname, const GLint *param); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLSAMPLERPARAMETERIUIVPROC) (GLuint sampler, GLenum pname, const GLuint *param); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETSAMPLERPARAMETERIVPROC) (GLuint sampler, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETSAMPLERPARAMETERIIVPROC) (GLuint sampler, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETSAMPLERPARAMETERFVPROC) (GLuint sampler, GLenum pname, GLfloat *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETSAMPLERPARAMETERIUIVPROC) (GLuint sampler, GLenum pname, GLuint *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLQUERYCOUNTERPROC) (GLuint id, GLenum target); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETQUERYOBJECTI64VPROC) (GLuint id, GLenum pname, GLint64 *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETQUERYOBJECTUI64VPROC) (GLuint id, GLenum pname, GLuint64 *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBDIVISORPROC) (GLuint index, GLuint divisor); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBP1UIPROC) (GLuint index, GLenum type, GLboolean normalized, GLuint value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBP1UIVPROC) (GLuint index, GLenum type, GLboolean normalized, const GLuint *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBP2UIPROC) (GLuint index, GLenum type, GLboolean normalized, GLuint value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBP2UIVPROC) (GLuint index, GLenum type, GLboolean normalized, const GLuint *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBP3UIPROC) (GLuint index, GLenum type, GLboolean normalized, GLuint value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBP3UIVPROC) (GLuint index, GLenum type, GLboolean normalized, const GLuint *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBP4UIPROC) (GLuint index, GLenum type, GLboolean normalized, GLuint value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBP4UIVPROC) (GLuint index, GLenum type, GLboolean normalized, const GLuint *value); +#ifdef GL_GLEXT_PROTOTYPES +GLAPI void APIENTRY glBindFragDataLocationIndexed (GLuint program, GLuint colorNumber, GLuint index, const GLchar *name); +GLAPI GLint APIENTRY glGetFragDataIndex (GLuint program, const GLchar *name); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGenSamplers (GLsizei count, GLuint *samplers); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDeleteSamplers (GLsizei count, const GLuint *samplers); +GLAPI GLboolean APIENTRY glIsSampler (GLuint sampler); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glBindSampler (GLuint unit, GLuint sampler); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glSamplerParameteri (GLuint sampler, GLenum pname, GLint param); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glSamplerParameteriv (GLuint sampler, GLenum pname, const GLint *param); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glSamplerParameterf (GLuint sampler, GLenum pname, GLfloat param); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glSamplerParameterfv (GLuint sampler, GLenum pname, const GLfloat *param); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glSamplerParameterIiv (GLuint sampler, GLenum pname, const GLint *param); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glSamplerParameterIuiv (GLuint sampler, GLenum pname, const GLuint *param); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetSamplerParameteriv (GLuint sampler, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetSamplerParameterIiv (GLuint sampler, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetSamplerParameterfv (GLuint sampler, GLenum pname, GLfloat *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetSamplerParameterIuiv (GLuint sampler, GLenum pname, GLuint *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glQueryCounter (GLuint id, GLenum target); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetQueryObjecti64v (GLuint id, GLenum pname, GLint64 *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetQueryObjectui64v (GLuint id, GLenum pname, GLuint64 *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttribDivisor (GLuint index, GLuint divisor); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttribP1ui (GLuint index, GLenum type, GLboolean normalized, GLuint value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttribP1uiv (GLuint index, GLenum type, GLboolean normalized, const GLuint *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttribP2ui (GLuint index, GLenum type, GLboolean normalized, GLuint value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttribP2uiv (GLuint index, GLenum type, GLboolean normalized, const GLuint *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttribP3ui (GLuint index, GLenum type, GLboolean normalized, GLuint value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttribP3uiv (GLuint index, GLenum type, GLboolean normalized, const GLuint *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttribP4ui (GLuint index, GLenum type, GLboolean normalized, GLuint value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttribP4uiv (GLuint index, GLenum type, GLboolean normalized, const GLuint *value); +#endif +#endif /* GL_VERSION_3_3 */ + +#ifndef GL_VERSION_4_0 +#define GL_VERSION_4_0 1 +#define GL_SAMPLE_SHADING 0x8C36 +#define GL_MIN_SAMPLE_SHADING_VALUE 0x8C37 +#define GL_MIN_PROGRAM_TEXTURE_GATHER_OFFSET 0x8E5E +#define GL_MAX_PROGRAM_TEXTURE_GATHER_OFFSET 0x8E5F +#define GL_TEXTURE_CUBE_MAP_ARRAY 0x9009 +#define GL_TEXTURE_BINDING_CUBE_MAP_ARRAY 0x900A +#define GL_PROXY_TEXTURE_CUBE_MAP_ARRAY 0x900B +#define GL_SAMPLER_CUBE_MAP_ARRAY 0x900C +#define GL_SAMPLER_CUBE_MAP_ARRAY_SHADOW 0x900D +#define GL_INT_SAMPLER_CUBE_MAP_ARRAY 0x900E +#define GL_UNSIGNED_INT_SAMPLER_CUBE_MAP_ARRAY 0x900F +#define GL_DRAW_INDIRECT_BUFFER 0x8F3F +#define GL_DRAW_INDIRECT_BUFFER_BINDING 0x8F43 +#define GL_GEOMETRY_SHADER_INVOCATIONS 0x887F +#define GL_MAX_GEOMETRY_SHADER_INVOCATIONS 0x8E5A +#define GL_MIN_FRAGMENT_INTERPOLATION_OFFSET 0x8E5B +#define GL_MAX_FRAGMENT_INTERPOLATION_OFFSET 0x8E5C +#define GL_FRAGMENT_INTERPOLATION_OFFSET_BITS 0x8E5D +#define GL_MAX_VERTEX_STREAMS 0x8E71 +#define GL_DOUBLE_VEC2 0x8FFC +#define GL_DOUBLE_VEC3 0x8FFD +#define GL_DOUBLE_VEC4 0x8FFE +#define GL_DOUBLE_MAT2 0x8F46 +#define GL_DOUBLE_MAT3 0x8F47 +#define GL_DOUBLE_MAT4 0x8F48 +#define GL_DOUBLE_MAT2x3 0x8F49 +#define GL_DOUBLE_MAT2x4 0x8F4A +#define GL_DOUBLE_MAT3x2 0x8F4B +#define GL_DOUBLE_MAT3x4 0x8F4C +#define GL_DOUBLE_MAT4x2 0x8F4D +#define GL_DOUBLE_MAT4x3 0x8F4E +#define GL_ACTIVE_SUBROUTINES 0x8DE5 +#define GL_ACTIVE_SUBROUTINE_UNIFORMS 0x8DE6 +#define GL_ACTIVE_SUBROUTINE_UNIFORM_LOCATIONS 0x8E47 +#define GL_ACTIVE_SUBROUTINE_MAX_LENGTH 0x8E48 +#define GL_ACTIVE_SUBROUTINE_UNIFORM_MAX_LENGTH 0x8E49 +#define GL_MAX_SUBROUTINES 0x8DE7 +#define GL_MAX_SUBROUTINE_UNIFORM_LOCATIONS 0x8DE8 +#define GL_NUM_COMPATIBLE_SUBROUTINES 0x8E4A +#define GL_COMPATIBLE_SUBROUTINES 0x8E4B +#define GL_PATCHES 0x000E +#define GL_PATCH_VERTICES 0x8E72 +#define GL_PATCH_DEFAULT_INNER_LEVEL 0x8E73 +#define GL_PATCH_DEFAULT_OUTER_LEVEL 0x8E74 +#define GL_TESS_CONTROL_OUTPUT_VERTICES 0x8E75 +#define GL_TESS_GEN_MODE 0x8E76 +#define GL_TESS_GEN_SPACING 0x8E77 +#define GL_TESS_GEN_VERTEX_ORDER 0x8E78 +#define GL_TESS_GEN_POINT_MODE 0x8E79 +#define GL_ISOLINES 0x8E7A +#define GL_FRACTIONAL_ODD 0x8E7B +#define GL_FRACTIONAL_EVEN 0x8E7C +#define GL_MAX_PATCH_VERTICES 0x8E7D +#define GL_MAX_TESS_GEN_LEVEL 0x8E7E +#define GL_MAX_TESS_CONTROL_UNIFORM_COMPONENTS 0x8E7F +#define GL_MAX_TESS_EVALUATION_UNIFORM_COMPONENTS 0x8E80 +#define GL_MAX_TESS_CONTROL_TEXTURE_IMAGE_UNITS 0x8E81 +#define GL_MAX_TESS_EVALUATION_TEXTURE_IMAGE_UNITS 0x8E82 +#define GL_MAX_TESS_CONTROL_OUTPUT_COMPONENTS 0x8E83 +#define GL_MAX_TESS_PATCH_COMPONENTS 0x8E84 +#define GL_MAX_TESS_CONTROL_TOTAL_OUTPUT_COMPONENTS 0x8E85 +#define GL_MAX_TESS_EVALUATION_OUTPUT_COMPONENTS 0x8E86 +#define GL_MAX_TESS_CONTROL_UNIFORM_BLOCKS 0x8E89 +#define GL_MAX_TESS_EVALUATION_UNIFORM_BLOCKS 0x8E8A +#define GL_MAX_TESS_CONTROL_INPUT_COMPONENTS 0x886C +#define GL_MAX_TESS_EVALUATION_INPUT_COMPONENTS 0x886D +#define GL_MAX_COMBINED_TESS_CONTROL_UNIFORM_COMPONENTS 0x8E1E +#define GL_MAX_COMBINED_TESS_EVALUATION_UNIFORM_COMPONENTS 0x8E1F +#define GL_UNIFORM_BLOCK_REFERENCED_BY_TESS_CONTROL_SHADER 0x84F0 +#define GL_UNIFORM_BLOCK_REFERENCED_BY_TESS_EVALUATION_SHADER 0x84F1 +#define GL_TESS_EVALUATION_SHADER 0x8E87 +#define GL_TESS_CONTROL_SHADER 0x8E88 +#define GL_TRANSFORM_FEEDBACK 0x8E22 +#define GL_TRANSFORM_FEEDBACK_BUFFER_PAUSED 0x8E23 +#define GL_TRANSFORM_FEEDBACK_BUFFER_ACTIVE 0x8E24 +#define GL_TRANSFORM_FEEDBACK_BINDING 0x8E25 +#define GL_MAX_TRANSFORM_FEEDBACK_BUFFERS 0x8E70 +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLMINSAMPLESHADINGPROC) (GLfloat value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLBLENDEQUATIONIPROC) (GLuint buf, GLenum mode); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLBLENDEQUATIONSEPARATEIPROC) (GLuint buf, GLenum modeRGB, GLenum modeAlpha); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLBLENDFUNCIPROC) (GLuint buf, GLenum src, GLenum dst); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLBLENDFUNCSEPARATEIPROC) (GLuint buf, GLenum srcRGB, GLenum dstRGB, GLenum srcAlpha, GLenum dstAlpha); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDRAWARRAYSINDIRECTPROC) (GLenum mode, const void *indirect); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDRAWELEMENTSINDIRECTPROC) (GLenum mode, GLenum type, const void *indirect); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLUNIFORM1DPROC) (GLint location, GLdouble x); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLUNIFORM2DPROC) (GLint location, GLdouble x, GLdouble y); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLUNIFORM3DPROC) (GLint location, GLdouble x, GLdouble y, GLdouble z); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLUNIFORM4DPROC) (GLint location, GLdouble x, GLdouble y, GLdouble z, GLdouble w); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLUNIFORM1DVPROC) (GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLdouble *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLUNIFORM2DVPROC) (GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLdouble *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLUNIFORM3DVPROC) (GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLdouble *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLUNIFORM4DVPROC) (GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLdouble *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX2DVPROC) (GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLdouble *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX3DVPROC) (GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLdouble *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX4DVPROC) (GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLdouble *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX2X3DVPROC) (GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLdouble *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX2X4DVPROC) (GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLdouble *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX3X2DVPROC) (GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLdouble *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX3X4DVPROC) (GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLdouble *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX4X2DVPROC) (GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLdouble *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX4X3DVPROC) (GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLdouble *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETUNIFORMDVPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLdouble *params); +typedef GLint (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETSUBROUTINEUNIFORMLOCATIONPROC) (GLuint program, GLenum shadertype, const GLchar *name); +typedef GLuint (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETSUBROUTINEINDEXPROC) (GLuint program, GLenum shadertype, const GLchar *name); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETACTIVESUBROUTINEUNIFORMIVPROC) (GLuint program, GLenum shadertype, GLuint index, GLenum pname, GLint *values); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETACTIVESUBROUTINEUNIFORMNAMEPROC) (GLuint program, GLenum shadertype, GLuint index, GLsizei bufsize, GLsizei *length, GLchar *name); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETACTIVESUBROUTINENAMEPROC) (GLuint program, GLenum shadertype, GLuint index, GLsizei bufsize, GLsizei *length, GLchar *name); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLUNIFORMSUBROUTINESUIVPROC) (GLenum shadertype, GLsizei count, const GLuint *indices); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETUNIFORMSUBROUTINEUIVPROC) (GLenum shadertype, GLint location, GLuint *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETPROGRAMSTAGEIVPROC) (GLuint program, GLenum shadertype, GLenum pname, GLint *values); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPATCHPARAMETERIPROC) (GLenum pname, GLint value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPATCHPARAMETERFVPROC) (GLenum pname, const GLfloat *values); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLBINDTRANSFORMFEEDBACKPROC) (GLenum target, GLuint id); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDELETETRANSFORMFEEDBACKSPROC) (GLsizei n, const GLuint *ids); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGENTRANSFORMFEEDBACKSPROC) (GLsizei n, GLuint *ids); +typedef GLboolean (APIENTRYP PFNGLISTRANSFORMFEEDBACKPROC) (GLuint id); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPAUSETRANSFORMFEEDBACKPROC) (void); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLRESUMETRANSFORMFEEDBACKPROC) (void); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDRAWTRANSFORMFEEDBACKPROC) (GLenum mode, GLuint id); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDRAWTRANSFORMFEEDBACKSTREAMPROC) (GLenum mode, GLuint id, GLuint stream); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLBEGINQUERYINDEXEDPROC) (GLenum target, GLuint index, GLuint id); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLENDQUERYINDEXEDPROC) (GLenum target, GLuint index); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETQUERYINDEXEDIVPROC) (GLenum target, GLuint index, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +#ifdef GL_GLEXT_PROTOTYPES +GLAPI void APIENTRY glMinSampleShading (GLfloat value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glBlendEquationi (GLuint buf, GLenum mode); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glBlendEquationSeparatei (GLuint buf, GLenum modeRGB, GLenum modeAlpha); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glBlendFunci (GLuint buf, GLenum src, GLenum dst); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glBlendFuncSeparatei (GLuint buf, GLenum srcRGB, GLenum dstRGB, GLenum srcAlpha, GLenum dstAlpha); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDrawArraysIndirect (GLenum mode, const void *indirect); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDrawElementsIndirect (GLenum mode, GLenum type, const void *indirect); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glUniform1d (GLint location, GLdouble x); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glUniform2d (GLint location, GLdouble x, GLdouble y); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glUniform3d (GLint location, GLdouble x, GLdouble y, GLdouble z); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glUniform4d (GLint location, GLdouble x, GLdouble y, GLdouble z, GLdouble w); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glUniform1dv (GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLdouble *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glUniform2dv (GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLdouble *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glUniform3dv (GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLdouble *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glUniform4dv (GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLdouble *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glUniformMatrix2dv (GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLdouble *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glUniformMatrix3dv (GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLdouble *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glUniformMatrix4dv (GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLdouble *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glUniformMatrix2x3dv (GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLdouble *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glUniformMatrix2x4dv (GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLdouble *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glUniformMatrix3x2dv (GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLdouble *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glUniformMatrix3x4dv (GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLdouble *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glUniformMatrix4x2dv (GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLdouble *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glUniformMatrix4x3dv (GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLdouble *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetUniformdv (GLuint program, GLint location, GLdouble *params); +GLAPI GLint APIENTRY glGetSubroutineUniformLocation (GLuint program, GLenum shadertype, const GLchar *name); +GLAPI GLuint APIENTRY glGetSubroutineIndex (GLuint program, GLenum shadertype, const GLchar *name); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetActiveSubroutineUniformiv (GLuint program, GLenum shadertype, GLuint index, GLenum pname, GLint *values); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetActiveSubroutineUniformName (GLuint program, GLenum shadertype, GLuint index, GLsizei bufsize, GLsizei *length, GLchar *name); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetActiveSubroutineName (GLuint program, GLenum shadertype, GLuint index, GLsizei bufsize, GLsizei *length, GLchar *name); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glUniformSubroutinesuiv (GLenum shadertype, GLsizei count, const GLuint *indices); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetUniformSubroutineuiv (GLenum shadertype, GLint location, GLuint *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetProgramStageiv (GLuint program, GLenum shadertype, GLenum pname, GLint *values); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glPatchParameteri (GLenum pname, GLint value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glPatchParameterfv (GLenum pname, const GLfloat *values); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glBindTransformFeedback (GLenum target, GLuint id); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDeleteTransformFeedbacks (GLsizei n, const GLuint *ids); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGenTransformFeedbacks (GLsizei n, GLuint *ids); +GLAPI GLboolean APIENTRY glIsTransformFeedback (GLuint id); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glPauseTransformFeedback (void); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glResumeTransformFeedback (void); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDrawTransformFeedback (GLenum mode, GLuint id); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDrawTransformFeedbackStream (GLenum mode, GLuint id, GLuint stream); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glBeginQueryIndexed (GLenum target, GLuint index, GLuint id); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glEndQueryIndexed (GLenum target, GLuint index); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetQueryIndexediv (GLenum target, GLuint index, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +#endif +#endif /* GL_VERSION_4_0 */ + +#ifndef GL_VERSION_4_1 +#define GL_VERSION_4_1 1 +#define GL_FIXED 0x140C +#define GL_IMPLEMENTATION_COLOR_READ_TYPE 0x8B9A +#define GL_IMPLEMENTATION_COLOR_READ_FORMAT 0x8B9B +#define GL_LOW_FLOAT 0x8DF0 +#define GL_MEDIUM_FLOAT 0x8DF1 +#define GL_HIGH_FLOAT 0x8DF2 +#define GL_LOW_INT 0x8DF3 +#define GL_MEDIUM_INT 0x8DF4 +#define GL_HIGH_INT 0x8DF5 +#define GL_SHADER_COMPILER 0x8DFA +#define GL_SHADER_BINARY_FORMATS 0x8DF8 +#define GL_NUM_SHADER_BINARY_FORMATS 0x8DF9 +#define GL_MAX_VERTEX_UNIFORM_VECTORS 0x8DFB +#define GL_MAX_VARYING_VECTORS 0x8DFC +#define GL_MAX_FRAGMENT_UNIFORM_VECTORS 0x8DFD +#define GL_RGB565 0x8D62 +#define GL_PROGRAM_BINARY_RETRIEVABLE_HINT 0x8257 +#define GL_PROGRAM_BINARY_LENGTH 0x8741 +#define GL_NUM_PROGRAM_BINARY_FORMATS 0x87FE +#define GL_PROGRAM_BINARY_FORMATS 0x87FF +#define GL_VERTEX_SHADER_BIT 0x00000001 +#define GL_FRAGMENT_SHADER_BIT 0x00000002 +#define GL_GEOMETRY_SHADER_BIT 0x00000004 +#define GL_TESS_CONTROL_SHADER_BIT 0x00000008 +#define GL_TESS_EVALUATION_SHADER_BIT 0x00000010 +#define GL_ALL_SHADER_BITS 0xFFFFFFFF +#define GL_PROGRAM_SEPARABLE 0x8258 +#define GL_ACTIVE_PROGRAM 0x8259 +#define GL_PROGRAM_PIPELINE_BINDING 0x825A +#define GL_MAX_VIEWPORTS 0x825B +#define GL_VIEWPORT_SUBPIXEL_BITS 0x825C +#define GL_VIEWPORT_BOUNDS_RANGE 0x825D +#define GL_LAYER_PROVOKING_VERTEX 0x825E +#define GL_VIEWPORT_INDEX_PROVOKING_VERTEX 0x825F +#define GL_UNDEFINED_VERTEX 0x8260 +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLRELEASESHADERCOMPILERPROC) (void); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLSHADERBINARYPROC) (GLsizei count, const GLuint *shaders, GLenum binaryformat, const void *binary, GLsizei length); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETSHADERPRECISIONFORMATPROC) (GLenum shadertype, GLenum precisiontype, GLint *range, GLint *precision); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDEPTHRANGEFPROC) (GLfloat n, GLfloat f); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLCLEARDEPTHFPROC) (GLfloat d); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETPROGRAMBINARYPROC) (GLuint program, GLsizei bufSize, GLsizei *length, GLenum *binaryFormat, void *binary); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPROGRAMBINARYPROC) (GLuint program, GLenum binaryFormat, const void *binary, GLsizei length); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPROGRAMPARAMETERIPROC) (GLuint program, GLenum pname, GLint value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLUSEPROGRAMSTAGESPROC) (GLuint pipeline, GLbitfield stages, GLuint program); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLACTIVESHADERPROGRAMPROC) (GLuint pipeline, GLuint program); +typedef GLuint (APIENTRYP PFNGLCREATESHADERPROGRAMVPROC) (GLenum type, GLsizei count, const GLchar *const*strings); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLBINDPROGRAMPIPELINEPROC) (GLuint pipeline); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDELETEPROGRAMPIPELINESPROC) (GLsizei n, const GLuint *pipelines); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGENPROGRAMPIPELINESPROC) (GLsizei n, GLuint *pipelines); +typedef GLboolean (APIENTRYP PFNGLISPROGRAMPIPELINEPROC) (GLuint pipeline); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETPROGRAMPIPELINEIVPROC) (GLuint pipeline, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM1IPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLint v0); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM1IVPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLint *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM1FPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLfloat v0); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM1FVPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLfloat *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM1DPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLdouble v0); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM1DVPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLdouble *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM1UIPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLuint v0); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM1UIVPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLuint *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM2IPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLint v0, GLint v1); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM2IVPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLint *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM2FPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLfloat v0, GLfloat v1); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM2FVPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLfloat *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM2DPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLdouble v0, GLdouble v1); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM2DVPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLdouble *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM2UIPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLuint v0, GLuint v1); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM2UIVPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLuint *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM3IPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLint v0, GLint v1, GLint v2); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM3IVPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLint *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM3FPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLfloat v0, GLfloat v1, GLfloat v2); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM3FVPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLfloat *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM3DPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLdouble v0, GLdouble v1, GLdouble v2); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM3DVPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLdouble *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM3UIPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLuint v0, GLuint v1, GLuint v2); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM3UIVPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLuint *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM4IPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLint v0, GLint v1, GLint v2, GLint v3); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM4IVPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLint *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM4FPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLfloat v0, GLfloat v1, GLfloat v2, GLfloat v3); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM4FVPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLfloat *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM4DPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLdouble v0, GLdouble v1, GLdouble v2, GLdouble v3); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM4DVPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLdouble *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM4UIPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLuint v0, GLuint v1, GLuint v2, GLuint v3); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM4UIVPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLuint *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX2FVPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLfloat *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX3FVPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLfloat *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX4FVPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLfloat *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX2DVPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLdouble *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX3DVPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLdouble *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX4DVPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLdouble *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX2X3FVPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLfloat *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX3X2FVPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLfloat *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX2X4FVPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLfloat *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX4X2FVPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLfloat *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX3X4FVPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLfloat *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX4X3FVPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLfloat *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX2X3DVPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLdouble *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX3X2DVPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLdouble *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX2X4DVPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLdouble *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX4X2DVPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLdouble *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX3X4DVPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLdouble *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX4X3DVPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLdouble *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVALIDATEPROGRAMPIPELINEPROC) (GLuint pipeline); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETPROGRAMPIPELINEINFOLOGPROC) (GLuint pipeline, GLsizei bufSize, GLsizei *length, GLchar *infoLog); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBL1DPROC) (GLuint index, GLdouble x); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBL2DPROC) (GLuint index, GLdouble x, GLdouble y); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBL3DPROC) (GLuint index, GLdouble x, GLdouble y, GLdouble z); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBL4DPROC) (GLuint index, GLdouble x, GLdouble y, GLdouble z, GLdouble w); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBL1DVPROC) (GLuint index, const GLdouble *v); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBL2DVPROC) (GLuint index, const GLdouble *v); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBL3DVPROC) (GLuint index, const GLdouble *v); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBL4DVPROC) (GLuint index, const GLdouble *v); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBLPOINTERPROC) (GLuint index, GLint size, GLenum type, GLsizei stride, const void *pointer); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETVERTEXATTRIBLDVPROC) (GLuint index, GLenum pname, GLdouble *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVIEWPORTARRAYVPROC) (GLuint first, GLsizei count, const GLfloat *v); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVIEWPORTINDEXEDFPROC) (GLuint index, GLfloat x, GLfloat y, GLfloat w, GLfloat h); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVIEWPORTINDEXEDFVPROC) (GLuint index, const GLfloat *v); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLSCISSORARRAYVPROC) (GLuint first, GLsizei count, const GLint *v); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLSCISSORINDEXEDPROC) (GLuint index, GLint left, GLint bottom, GLsizei width, GLsizei height); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLSCISSORINDEXEDVPROC) (GLuint index, const GLint *v); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDEPTHRANGEARRAYVPROC) (GLuint first, GLsizei count, const GLdouble *v); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDEPTHRANGEINDEXEDPROC) (GLuint index, GLdouble n, GLdouble f); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETFLOATI_VPROC) (GLenum target, GLuint index, GLfloat *data); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETDOUBLEI_VPROC) (GLenum target, GLuint index, GLdouble *data); +#ifdef GL_GLEXT_PROTOTYPES +GLAPI void APIENTRY glReleaseShaderCompiler (void); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glShaderBinary (GLsizei count, const GLuint *shaders, GLenum binaryformat, const void *binary, GLsizei length); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetShaderPrecisionFormat (GLenum shadertype, GLenum precisiontype, GLint *range, GLint *precision); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDepthRangef (GLfloat n, GLfloat f); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glClearDepthf (GLfloat d); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetProgramBinary (GLuint program, GLsizei bufSize, GLsizei *length, GLenum *binaryFormat, void *binary); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glProgramBinary (GLuint program, GLenum binaryFormat, const void *binary, GLsizei length); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glProgramParameteri (GLuint program, GLenum pname, GLint value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glUseProgramStages (GLuint pipeline, GLbitfield stages, GLuint program); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glActiveShaderProgram (GLuint pipeline, GLuint program); +GLAPI GLuint APIENTRY glCreateShaderProgramv (GLenum type, GLsizei count, const GLchar *const*strings); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glBindProgramPipeline (GLuint pipeline); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDeleteProgramPipelines (GLsizei n, const GLuint *pipelines); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGenProgramPipelines (GLsizei n, GLuint *pipelines); +GLAPI GLboolean APIENTRY glIsProgramPipeline (GLuint pipeline); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetProgramPipelineiv (GLuint pipeline, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glProgramUniform1i (GLuint program, GLint location, GLint v0); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glProgramUniform1iv (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLint *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glProgramUniform1f (GLuint program, GLint location, GLfloat v0); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glProgramUniform1fv (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLfloat *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glProgramUniform1d (GLuint program, GLint location, GLdouble v0); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glProgramUniform1dv (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLdouble *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glProgramUniform1ui (GLuint program, GLint location, GLuint v0); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glProgramUniform1uiv (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLuint *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glProgramUniform2i (GLuint program, GLint location, GLint v0, GLint v1); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glProgramUniform2iv (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLint *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glProgramUniform2f (GLuint program, GLint location, GLfloat v0, GLfloat v1); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glProgramUniform2fv (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLfloat *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glProgramUniform2d (GLuint program, GLint location, GLdouble v0, GLdouble v1); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glProgramUniform2dv (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLdouble *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glProgramUniform2ui (GLuint program, GLint location, GLuint v0, GLuint v1); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glProgramUniform2uiv (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLuint *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glProgramUniform3i (GLuint program, GLint location, GLint v0, GLint v1, GLint v2); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glProgramUniform3iv (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLint *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glProgramUniform3f (GLuint program, GLint location, GLfloat v0, GLfloat v1, GLfloat v2); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glProgramUniform3fv (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLfloat *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glProgramUniform3d (GLuint program, GLint location, GLdouble v0, GLdouble v1, GLdouble v2); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glProgramUniform3dv (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLdouble *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glProgramUniform3ui (GLuint program, GLint location, GLuint v0, GLuint v1, GLuint v2); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glProgramUniform3uiv (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLuint *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glProgramUniform4i (GLuint program, GLint location, GLint v0, GLint v1, GLint v2, GLint v3); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glProgramUniform4iv (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLint *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glProgramUniform4f (GLuint program, GLint location, GLfloat v0, GLfloat v1, GLfloat v2, GLfloat v3); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glProgramUniform4fv (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLfloat *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glProgramUniform4d (GLuint program, GLint location, GLdouble v0, GLdouble v1, GLdouble v2, GLdouble v3); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glProgramUniform4dv (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLdouble *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glProgramUniform4ui (GLuint program, GLint location, GLuint v0, GLuint v1, GLuint v2, GLuint v3); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glProgramUniform4uiv (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLuint *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glProgramUniformMatrix2fv (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLfloat *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glProgramUniformMatrix3fv (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLfloat *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glProgramUniformMatrix4fv (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLfloat *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glProgramUniformMatrix2dv (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLdouble *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glProgramUniformMatrix3dv (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLdouble *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glProgramUniformMatrix4dv (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLdouble *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glProgramUniformMatrix2x3fv (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLfloat *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glProgramUniformMatrix3x2fv (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLfloat *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glProgramUniformMatrix2x4fv (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLfloat *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glProgramUniformMatrix4x2fv (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLfloat *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glProgramUniformMatrix3x4fv (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLfloat *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glProgramUniformMatrix4x3fv (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLfloat *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glProgramUniformMatrix2x3dv (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLdouble *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glProgramUniformMatrix3x2dv (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLdouble *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glProgramUniformMatrix2x4dv (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLdouble *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glProgramUniformMatrix4x2dv (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLdouble *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glProgramUniformMatrix3x4dv (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLdouble *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glProgramUniformMatrix4x3dv (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLdouble *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glValidateProgramPipeline (GLuint pipeline); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetProgramPipelineInfoLog (GLuint pipeline, GLsizei bufSize, GLsizei *length, GLchar *infoLog); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttribL1d (GLuint index, GLdouble x); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttribL2d (GLuint index, GLdouble x, GLdouble y); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttribL3d (GLuint index, GLdouble x, GLdouble y, GLdouble z); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttribL4d (GLuint index, GLdouble x, GLdouble y, GLdouble z, GLdouble w); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttribL1dv (GLuint index, const GLdouble *v); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttribL2dv (GLuint index, const GLdouble *v); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttribL3dv (GLuint index, const GLdouble *v); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttribL4dv (GLuint index, const GLdouble *v); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttribLPointer (GLuint index, GLint size, GLenum type, GLsizei stride, const void *pointer); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetVertexAttribLdv (GLuint index, GLenum pname, GLdouble *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glViewportArrayv (GLuint first, GLsizei count, const GLfloat *v); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glViewportIndexedf (GLuint index, GLfloat x, GLfloat y, GLfloat w, GLfloat h); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glViewportIndexedfv (GLuint index, const GLfloat *v); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glScissorArrayv (GLuint first, GLsizei count, const GLint *v); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glScissorIndexed (GLuint index, GLint left, GLint bottom, GLsizei width, GLsizei height); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glScissorIndexedv (GLuint index, const GLint *v); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDepthRangeArrayv (GLuint first, GLsizei count, const GLdouble *v); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDepthRangeIndexed (GLuint index, GLdouble n, GLdouble f); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetFloati_v (GLenum target, GLuint index, GLfloat *data); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetDoublei_v (GLenum target, GLuint index, GLdouble *data); +#endif +#endif /* GL_VERSION_4_1 */ + +#ifndef GL_VERSION_4_2 +#define GL_VERSION_4_2 1 +#define GL_COPY_READ_BUFFER_BINDING 0x8F36 +#define GL_COPY_WRITE_BUFFER_BINDING 0x8F37 +#define GL_TRANSFORM_FEEDBACK_ACTIVE 0x8E24 +#define GL_TRANSFORM_FEEDBACK_PAUSED 0x8E23 +#define GL_UNPACK_COMPRESSED_BLOCK_WIDTH 0x9127 +#define GL_UNPACK_COMPRESSED_BLOCK_HEIGHT 0x9128 +#define GL_UNPACK_COMPRESSED_BLOCK_DEPTH 0x9129 +#define GL_UNPACK_COMPRESSED_BLOCK_SIZE 0x912A +#define GL_PACK_COMPRESSED_BLOCK_WIDTH 0x912B +#define GL_PACK_COMPRESSED_BLOCK_HEIGHT 0x912C +#define GL_PACK_COMPRESSED_BLOCK_DEPTH 0x912D +#define GL_PACK_COMPRESSED_BLOCK_SIZE 0x912E +#define GL_NUM_SAMPLE_COUNTS 0x9380 +#define GL_MIN_MAP_BUFFER_ALIGNMENT 0x90BC +#define GL_ATOMIC_COUNTER_BUFFER 0x92C0 +#define GL_ATOMIC_COUNTER_BUFFER_BINDING 0x92C1 +#define GL_ATOMIC_COUNTER_BUFFER_START 0x92C2 +#define GL_ATOMIC_COUNTER_BUFFER_SIZE 0x92C3 +#define GL_ATOMIC_COUNTER_BUFFER_DATA_SIZE 0x92C4 +#define GL_ATOMIC_COUNTER_BUFFER_ACTIVE_ATOMIC_COUNTERS 0x92C5 +#define GL_ATOMIC_COUNTER_BUFFER_ACTIVE_ATOMIC_COUNTER_INDICES 0x92C6 +#define GL_ATOMIC_COUNTER_BUFFER_REFERENCED_BY_VERTEX_SHADER 0x92C7 +#define GL_ATOMIC_COUNTER_BUFFER_REFERENCED_BY_TESS_CONTROL_SHADER 0x92C8 +#define GL_ATOMIC_COUNTER_BUFFER_REFERENCED_BY_TESS_EVALUATION_SHADER 0x92C9 +#define GL_ATOMIC_COUNTER_BUFFER_REFERENCED_BY_GEOMETRY_SHADER 0x92CA +#define GL_ATOMIC_COUNTER_BUFFER_REFERENCED_BY_FRAGMENT_SHADER 0x92CB +#define GL_MAX_VERTEX_ATOMIC_COUNTER_BUFFERS 0x92CC +#define GL_MAX_TESS_CONTROL_ATOMIC_COUNTER_BUFFERS 0x92CD +#define GL_MAX_TESS_EVALUATION_ATOMIC_COUNTER_BUFFERS 0x92CE +#define GL_MAX_GEOMETRY_ATOMIC_COUNTER_BUFFERS 0x92CF +#define GL_MAX_FRAGMENT_ATOMIC_COUNTER_BUFFERS 0x92D0 +#define GL_MAX_COMBINED_ATOMIC_COUNTER_BUFFERS 0x92D1 +#define GL_MAX_VERTEX_ATOMIC_COUNTERS 0x92D2 +#define GL_MAX_TESS_CONTROL_ATOMIC_COUNTERS 0x92D3 +#define GL_MAX_TESS_EVALUATION_ATOMIC_COUNTERS 0x92D4 +#define GL_MAX_GEOMETRY_ATOMIC_COUNTERS 0x92D5 +#define GL_MAX_FRAGMENT_ATOMIC_COUNTERS 0x92D6 +#define GL_MAX_COMBINED_ATOMIC_COUNTERS 0x92D7 +#define GL_MAX_ATOMIC_COUNTER_BUFFER_SIZE 0x92D8 +#define GL_MAX_ATOMIC_COUNTER_BUFFER_BINDINGS 0x92DC +#define GL_ACTIVE_ATOMIC_COUNTER_BUFFERS 0x92D9 +#define GL_UNIFORM_ATOMIC_COUNTER_BUFFER_INDEX 0x92DA +#define GL_UNSIGNED_INT_ATOMIC_COUNTER 0x92DB +#define GL_VERTEX_ATTRIB_ARRAY_BARRIER_BIT 0x00000001 +#define GL_ELEMENT_ARRAY_BARRIER_BIT 0x00000002 +#define GL_UNIFORM_BARRIER_BIT 0x00000004 +#define GL_TEXTURE_FETCH_BARRIER_BIT 0x00000008 +#define GL_SHADER_IMAGE_ACCESS_BARRIER_BIT 0x00000020 +#define GL_COMMAND_BARRIER_BIT 0x00000040 +#define GL_PIXEL_BUFFER_BARRIER_BIT 0x00000080 +#define GL_TEXTURE_UPDATE_BARRIER_BIT 0x00000100 +#define GL_BUFFER_UPDATE_BARRIER_BIT 0x00000200 +#define GL_FRAMEBUFFER_BARRIER_BIT 0x00000400 +#define GL_TRANSFORM_FEEDBACK_BARRIER_BIT 0x00000800 +#define GL_ATOMIC_COUNTER_BARRIER_BIT 0x00001000 +#define GL_ALL_BARRIER_BITS 0xFFFFFFFF +#define GL_MAX_IMAGE_UNITS 0x8F38 +#define GL_MAX_COMBINED_IMAGE_UNITS_AND_FRAGMENT_OUTPUTS 0x8F39 +#define GL_IMAGE_BINDING_NAME 0x8F3A +#define GL_IMAGE_BINDING_LEVEL 0x8F3B +#define GL_IMAGE_BINDING_LAYERED 0x8F3C +#define GL_IMAGE_BINDING_LAYER 0x8F3D +#define GL_IMAGE_BINDING_ACCESS 0x8F3E +#define GL_IMAGE_1D 0x904C +#define GL_IMAGE_2D 0x904D +#define GL_IMAGE_3D 0x904E +#define GL_IMAGE_2D_RECT 0x904F +#define GL_IMAGE_CUBE 0x9050 +#define GL_IMAGE_BUFFER 0x9051 +#define GL_IMAGE_1D_ARRAY 0x9052 +#define GL_IMAGE_2D_ARRAY 0x9053 +#define GL_IMAGE_CUBE_MAP_ARRAY 0x9054 +#define GL_IMAGE_2D_MULTISAMPLE 0x9055 +#define GL_IMAGE_2D_MULTISAMPLE_ARRAY 0x9056 +#define GL_INT_IMAGE_1D 0x9057 +#define GL_INT_IMAGE_2D 0x9058 +#define GL_INT_IMAGE_3D 0x9059 +#define GL_INT_IMAGE_2D_RECT 0x905A +#define GL_INT_IMAGE_CUBE 0x905B +#define GL_INT_IMAGE_BUFFER 0x905C +#define GL_INT_IMAGE_1D_ARRAY 0x905D +#define GL_INT_IMAGE_2D_ARRAY 0x905E +#define GL_INT_IMAGE_CUBE_MAP_ARRAY 0x905F +#define GL_INT_IMAGE_2D_MULTISAMPLE 0x9060 +#define GL_INT_IMAGE_2D_MULTISAMPLE_ARRAY 0x9061 +#define GL_UNSIGNED_INT_IMAGE_1D 0x9062 +#define GL_UNSIGNED_INT_IMAGE_2D 0x9063 +#define GL_UNSIGNED_INT_IMAGE_3D 0x9064 +#define GL_UNSIGNED_INT_IMAGE_2D_RECT 0x9065 +#define GL_UNSIGNED_INT_IMAGE_CUBE 0x9066 +#define GL_UNSIGNED_INT_IMAGE_BUFFER 0x9067 +#define GL_UNSIGNED_INT_IMAGE_1D_ARRAY 0x9068 +#define GL_UNSIGNED_INT_IMAGE_2D_ARRAY 0x9069 +#define GL_UNSIGNED_INT_IMAGE_CUBE_MAP_ARRAY 0x906A +#define GL_UNSIGNED_INT_IMAGE_2D_MULTISAMPLE 0x906B +#define GL_UNSIGNED_INT_IMAGE_2D_MULTISAMPLE_ARRAY 0x906C +#define GL_MAX_IMAGE_SAMPLES 0x906D +#define GL_IMAGE_BINDING_FORMAT 0x906E +#define GL_IMAGE_FORMAT_COMPATIBILITY_TYPE 0x90C7 +#define GL_IMAGE_FORMAT_COMPATIBILITY_BY_SIZE 0x90C8 +#define GL_IMAGE_FORMAT_COMPATIBILITY_BY_CLASS 0x90C9 +#define GL_MAX_VERTEX_IMAGE_UNIFORMS 0x90CA +#define GL_MAX_TESS_CONTROL_IMAGE_UNIFORMS 0x90CB +#define GL_MAX_TESS_EVALUATION_IMAGE_UNIFORMS 0x90CC +#define GL_MAX_GEOMETRY_IMAGE_UNIFORMS 0x90CD +#define GL_MAX_FRAGMENT_IMAGE_UNIFORMS 0x90CE +#define GL_MAX_COMBINED_IMAGE_UNIFORMS 0x90CF +#define GL_COMPRESSED_RGBA_BPTC_UNORM 0x8E8C +#define GL_COMPRESSED_SRGB_ALPHA_BPTC_UNORM 0x8E8D +#define GL_COMPRESSED_RGB_BPTC_SIGNED_FLOAT 0x8E8E +#define GL_COMPRESSED_RGB_BPTC_UNSIGNED_FLOAT 0x8E8F +#define GL_TEXTURE_IMMUTABLE_FORMAT 0x912F +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDRAWARRAYSINSTANCEDBASEINSTANCEPROC) (GLenum mode, GLint first, GLsizei count, GLsizei instancecount, GLuint baseinstance); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDRAWELEMENTSINSTANCEDBASEINSTANCEPROC) (GLenum mode, GLsizei count, GLenum type, const void *indices, GLsizei instancecount, GLuint baseinstance); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDRAWELEMENTSINSTANCEDBASEVERTEXBASEINSTANCEPROC) (GLenum mode, GLsizei count, GLenum type, const void *indices, GLsizei instancecount, GLint basevertex, GLuint baseinstance); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETINTERNALFORMATIVPROC) (GLenum target, GLenum internalformat, GLenum pname, GLsizei bufSize, GLint *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETACTIVEATOMICCOUNTERBUFFERIVPROC) (GLuint program, GLuint bufferIndex, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLBINDIMAGETEXTUREPROC) (GLuint unit, GLuint texture, GLint level, GLboolean layered, GLint layer, GLenum access, GLenum format); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLMEMORYBARRIERPROC) (GLbitfield barriers); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLTEXSTORAGE1DPROC) (GLenum target, GLsizei levels, GLenum internalformat, GLsizei width); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLTEXSTORAGE2DPROC) (GLenum target, GLsizei levels, GLenum internalformat, GLsizei width, GLsizei height); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLTEXSTORAGE3DPROC) (GLenum target, GLsizei levels, GLenum internalformat, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLsizei depth); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDRAWTRANSFORMFEEDBACKINSTANCEDPROC) (GLenum mode, GLuint id, GLsizei instancecount); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDRAWTRANSFORMFEEDBACKSTREAMINSTANCEDPROC) (GLenum mode, GLuint id, GLuint stream, GLsizei instancecount); +#ifdef GL_GLEXT_PROTOTYPES +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDrawArraysInstancedBaseInstance (GLenum mode, GLint first, GLsizei count, GLsizei instancecount, GLuint baseinstance); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDrawElementsInstancedBaseInstance (GLenum mode, GLsizei count, GLenum type, const void *indices, GLsizei instancecount, GLuint baseinstance); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDrawElementsInstancedBaseVertexBaseInstance (GLenum mode, GLsizei count, GLenum type, const void *indices, GLsizei instancecount, GLint basevertex, GLuint baseinstance); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetInternalformativ (GLenum target, GLenum internalformat, GLenum pname, GLsizei bufSize, GLint *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetActiveAtomicCounterBufferiv (GLuint program, GLuint bufferIndex, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glBindImageTexture (GLuint unit, GLuint texture, GLint level, GLboolean layered, GLint layer, GLenum access, GLenum format); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glMemoryBarrier (GLbitfield barriers); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glTexStorage1D (GLenum target, GLsizei levels, GLenum internalformat, GLsizei width); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glTexStorage2D (GLenum target, GLsizei levels, GLenum internalformat, GLsizei width, GLsizei height); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glTexStorage3D (GLenum target, GLsizei levels, GLenum internalformat, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLsizei depth); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDrawTransformFeedbackInstanced (GLenum mode, GLuint id, GLsizei instancecount); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDrawTransformFeedbackStreamInstanced (GLenum mode, GLuint id, GLuint stream, GLsizei instancecount); +#endif +#endif /* GL_VERSION_4_2 */ + +#ifndef GL_VERSION_4_3 +#define GL_VERSION_4_3 1 +typedef void (APIENTRY *GLDEBUGPROC)(GLenum source,GLenum type,GLuint id,GLenum severity,GLsizei length,const GLchar *message,const void *userParam); +#define GL_NUM_SHADING_LANGUAGE_VERSIONS 0x82E9 +#define GL_VERTEX_ATTRIB_ARRAY_LONG 0x874E +#define GL_COMPRESSED_RGB8_ETC2 0x9274 +#define GL_COMPRESSED_SRGB8_ETC2 0x9275 +#define GL_COMPRESSED_RGB8_PUNCHTHROUGH_ALPHA1_ETC2 0x9276 +#define GL_COMPRESSED_SRGB8_PUNCHTHROUGH_ALPHA1_ETC2 0x9277 +#define GL_COMPRESSED_RGBA8_ETC2_EAC 0x9278 +#define GL_COMPRESSED_SRGB8_ALPHA8_ETC2_EAC 0x9279 +#define GL_COMPRESSED_R11_EAC 0x9270 +#define GL_COMPRESSED_SIGNED_R11_EAC 0x9271 +#define GL_COMPRESSED_RG11_EAC 0x9272 +#define GL_COMPRESSED_SIGNED_RG11_EAC 0x9273 +#define GL_PRIMITIVE_RESTART_FIXED_INDEX 0x8D69 +#define GL_ANY_SAMPLES_PASSED_CONSERVATIVE 0x8D6A +#define GL_MAX_ELEMENT_INDEX 0x8D6B +#define GL_COMPUTE_SHADER 0x91B9 +#define GL_MAX_COMPUTE_UNIFORM_BLOCKS 0x91BB +#define GL_MAX_COMPUTE_TEXTURE_IMAGE_UNITS 0x91BC +#define GL_MAX_COMPUTE_IMAGE_UNIFORMS 0x91BD +#define GL_MAX_COMPUTE_SHARED_MEMORY_SIZE 0x8262 +#define GL_MAX_COMPUTE_UNIFORM_COMPONENTS 0x8263 +#define GL_MAX_COMPUTE_ATOMIC_COUNTER_BUFFERS 0x8264 +#define GL_MAX_COMPUTE_ATOMIC_COUNTERS 0x8265 +#define GL_MAX_COMBINED_COMPUTE_UNIFORM_COMPONENTS 0x8266 +#define GL_MAX_COMPUTE_WORK_GROUP_INVOCATIONS 0x90EB +#define GL_MAX_COMPUTE_WORK_GROUP_COUNT 0x91BE +#define GL_MAX_COMPUTE_WORK_GROUP_SIZE 0x91BF +#define GL_COMPUTE_WORK_GROUP_SIZE 0x8267 +#define GL_UNIFORM_BLOCK_REFERENCED_BY_COMPUTE_SHADER 0x90EC +#define GL_ATOMIC_COUNTER_BUFFER_REFERENCED_BY_COMPUTE_SHADER 0x90ED +#define GL_DISPATCH_INDIRECT_BUFFER 0x90EE +#define GL_DISPATCH_INDIRECT_BUFFER_BINDING 0x90EF +#define GL_COMPUTE_SHADER_BIT 0x00000020 +#define GL_DEBUG_OUTPUT_SYNCHRONOUS 0x8242 +#define GL_DEBUG_NEXT_LOGGED_MESSAGE_LENGTH 0x8243 +#define GL_DEBUG_CALLBACK_FUNCTION 0x8244 +#define GL_DEBUG_CALLBACK_USER_PARAM 0x8245 +#define GL_DEBUG_SOURCE_API 0x8246 +#define GL_DEBUG_SOURCE_WINDOW_SYSTEM 0x8247 +#define GL_DEBUG_SOURCE_SHADER_COMPILER 0x8248 +#define GL_DEBUG_SOURCE_THIRD_PARTY 0x8249 +#define GL_DEBUG_SOURCE_APPLICATION 0x824A +#define GL_DEBUG_SOURCE_OTHER 0x824B +#define GL_DEBUG_TYPE_ERROR 0x824C +#define GL_DEBUG_TYPE_DEPRECATED_BEHAVIOR 0x824D +#define GL_DEBUG_TYPE_UNDEFINED_BEHAVIOR 0x824E +#define GL_DEBUG_TYPE_PORTABILITY 0x824F +#define GL_DEBUG_TYPE_PERFORMANCE 0x8250 +#define GL_DEBUG_TYPE_OTHER 0x8251 +#define GL_MAX_DEBUG_MESSAGE_LENGTH 0x9143 +#define GL_MAX_DEBUG_LOGGED_MESSAGES 0x9144 +#define GL_DEBUG_LOGGED_MESSAGES 0x9145 +#define GL_DEBUG_SEVERITY_HIGH 0x9146 +#define GL_DEBUG_SEVERITY_MEDIUM 0x9147 +#define GL_DEBUG_SEVERITY_LOW 0x9148 +#define GL_DEBUG_TYPE_MARKER 0x8268 +#define GL_DEBUG_TYPE_PUSH_GROUP 0x8269 +#define GL_DEBUG_TYPE_POP_GROUP 0x826A +#define GL_DEBUG_SEVERITY_NOTIFICATION 0x826B +#define GL_MAX_DEBUG_GROUP_STACK_DEPTH 0x826C +#define GL_DEBUG_GROUP_STACK_DEPTH 0x826D +#define GL_BUFFER 0x82E0 +#define GL_SHADER 0x82E1 +#define GL_PROGRAM 0x82E2 +#define GL_QUERY 0x82E3 +#define GL_PROGRAM_PIPELINE 0x82E4 +#define GL_SAMPLER 0x82E6 +#define GL_MAX_LABEL_LENGTH 0x82E8 +#define GL_DEBUG_OUTPUT 0x92E0 +#define GL_CONTEXT_FLAG_DEBUG_BIT 0x00000002 +#define GL_MAX_UNIFORM_LOCATIONS 0x826E +#define GL_FRAMEBUFFER_DEFAULT_WIDTH 0x9310 +#define GL_FRAMEBUFFER_DEFAULT_HEIGHT 0x9311 +#define GL_FRAMEBUFFER_DEFAULT_LAYERS 0x9312 +#define GL_FRAMEBUFFER_DEFAULT_SAMPLES 0x9313 +#define GL_FRAMEBUFFER_DEFAULT_FIXED_SAMPLE_LOCATIONS 0x9314 +#define GL_MAX_FRAMEBUFFER_WIDTH 0x9315 +#define GL_MAX_FRAMEBUFFER_HEIGHT 0x9316 +#define GL_MAX_FRAMEBUFFER_LAYERS 0x9317 +#define GL_MAX_FRAMEBUFFER_SAMPLES 0x9318 +#define GL_INTERNALFORMAT_SUPPORTED 0x826F +#define GL_INTERNALFORMAT_PREFERRED 0x8270 +#define GL_INTERNALFORMAT_RED_SIZE 0x8271 +#define GL_INTERNALFORMAT_GREEN_SIZE 0x8272 +#define GL_INTERNALFORMAT_BLUE_SIZE 0x8273 +#define GL_INTERNALFORMAT_ALPHA_SIZE 0x8274 +#define GL_INTERNALFORMAT_DEPTH_SIZE 0x8275 +#define GL_INTERNALFORMAT_STENCIL_SIZE 0x8276 +#define GL_INTERNALFORMAT_SHARED_SIZE 0x8277 +#define GL_INTERNALFORMAT_RED_TYPE 0x8278 +#define GL_INTERNALFORMAT_GREEN_TYPE 0x8279 +#define GL_INTERNALFORMAT_BLUE_TYPE 0x827A +#define GL_INTERNALFORMAT_ALPHA_TYPE 0x827B +#define GL_INTERNALFORMAT_DEPTH_TYPE 0x827C +#define GL_INTERNALFORMAT_STENCIL_TYPE 0x827D +#define GL_MAX_WIDTH 0x827E +#define GL_MAX_HEIGHT 0x827F +#define GL_MAX_DEPTH 0x8280 +#define GL_MAX_LAYERS 0x8281 +#define GL_MAX_COMBINED_DIMENSIONS 0x8282 +#define GL_COLOR_COMPONENTS 0x8283 +#define GL_DEPTH_COMPONENTS 0x8284 +#define GL_STENCIL_COMPONENTS 0x8285 +#define GL_COLOR_RENDERABLE 0x8286 +#define GL_DEPTH_RENDERABLE 0x8287 +#define GL_STENCIL_RENDERABLE 0x8288 +#define GL_FRAMEBUFFER_RENDERABLE 0x8289 +#define GL_FRAMEBUFFER_RENDERABLE_LAYERED 0x828A +#define GL_FRAMEBUFFER_BLEND 0x828B +#define GL_READ_PIXELS 0x828C +#define GL_READ_PIXELS_FORMAT 0x828D +#define GL_READ_PIXELS_TYPE 0x828E +#define GL_TEXTURE_IMAGE_FORMAT 0x828F +#define GL_TEXTURE_IMAGE_TYPE 0x8290 +#define GL_GET_TEXTURE_IMAGE_FORMAT 0x8291 +#define GL_GET_TEXTURE_IMAGE_TYPE 0x8292 +#define GL_MIPMAP 0x8293 +#define GL_MANUAL_GENERATE_MIPMAP 0x8294 +#define GL_AUTO_GENERATE_MIPMAP 0x8295 +#define GL_COLOR_ENCODING 0x8296 +#define GL_SRGB_READ 0x8297 +#define GL_SRGB_WRITE 0x8298 +#define GL_FILTER 0x829A +#define GL_VERTEX_TEXTURE 0x829B +#define GL_TESS_CONTROL_TEXTURE 0x829C +#define GL_TESS_EVALUATION_TEXTURE 0x829D +#define GL_GEOMETRY_TEXTURE 0x829E +#define GL_FRAGMENT_TEXTURE 0x829F +#define GL_COMPUTE_TEXTURE 0x82A0 +#define GL_TEXTURE_SHADOW 0x82A1 +#define GL_TEXTURE_GATHER 0x82A2 +#define GL_TEXTURE_GATHER_SHADOW 0x82A3 +#define GL_SHADER_IMAGE_LOAD 0x82A4 +#define GL_SHADER_IMAGE_STORE 0x82A5 +#define GL_SHADER_IMAGE_ATOMIC 0x82A6 +#define GL_IMAGE_TEXEL_SIZE 0x82A7 +#define GL_IMAGE_COMPATIBILITY_CLASS 0x82A8 +#define GL_IMAGE_PIXEL_FORMAT 0x82A9 +#define GL_IMAGE_PIXEL_TYPE 0x82AA +#define GL_SIMULTANEOUS_TEXTURE_AND_DEPTH_TEST 0x82AC +#define GL_SIMULTANEOUS_TEXTURE_AND_STENCIL_TEST 0x82AD +#define GL_SIMULTANEOUS_TEXTURE_AND_DEPTH_WRITE 0x82AE +#define GL_SIMULTANEOUS_TEXTURE_AND_STENCIL_WRITE 0x82AF +#define GL_TEXTURE_COMPRESSED_BLOCK_WIDTH 0x82B1 +#define GL_TEXTURE_COMPRESSED_BLOCK_HEIGHT 0x82B2 +#define GL_TEXTURE_COMPRESSED_BLOCK_SIZE 0x82B3 +#define GL_CLEAR_BUFFER 0x82B4 +#define GL_TEXTURE_VIEW 0x82B5 +#define GL_VIEW_COMPATIBILITY_CLASS 0x82B6 +#define GL_FULL_SUPPORT 0x82B7 +#define GL_CAVEAT_SUPPORT 0x82B8 +#define GL_IMAGE_CLASS_4_X_32 0x82B9 +#define GL_IMAGE_CLASS_2_X_32 0x82BA +#define GL_IMAGE_CLASS_1_X_32 0x82BB +#define GL_IMAGE_CLASS_4_X_16 0x82BC +#define GL_IMAGE_CLASS_2_X_16 0x82BD +#define GL_IMAGE_CLASS_1_X_16 0x82BE +#define GL_IMAGE_CLASS_4_X_8 0x82BF +#define GL_IMAGE_CLASS_2_X_8 0x82C0 +#define GL_IMAGE_CLASS_1_X_8 0x82C1 +#define GL_IMAGE_CLASS_11_11_10 0x82C2 +#define GL_IMAGE_CLASS_10_10_10_2 0x82C3 +#define GL_VIEW_CLASS_128_BITS 0x82C4 +#define GL_VIEW_CLASS_96_BITS 0x82C5 +#define GL_VIEW_CLASS_64_BITS 0x82C6 +#define GL_VIEW_CLASS_48_BITS 0x82C7 +#define GL_VIEW_CLASS_32_BITS 0x82C8 +#define GL_VIEW_CLASS_24_BITS 0x82C9 +#define GL_VIEW_CLASS_16_BITS 0x82CA +#define GL_VIEW_CLASS_8_BITS 0x82CB +#define GL_VIEW_CLASS_S3TC_DXT1_RGB 0x82CC +#define GL_VIEW_CLASS_S3TC_DXT1_RGBA 0x82CD +#define GL_VIEW_CLASS_S3TC_DXT3_RGBA 0x82CE +#define GL_VIEW_CLASS_S3TC_DXT5_RGBA 0x82CF +#define GL_VIEW_CLASS_RGTC1_RED 0x82D0 +#define GL_VIEW_CLASS_RGTC2_RG 0x82D1 +#define GL_VIEW_CLASS_BPTC_UNORM 0x82D2 +#define GL_VIEW_CLASS_BPTC_FLOAT 0x82D3 +#define GL_UNIFORM 0x92E1 +#define GL_UNIFORM_BLOCK 0x92E2 +#define GL_PROGRAM_INPUT 0x92E3 +#define GL_PROGRAM_OUTPUT 0x92E4 +#define GL_BUFFER_VARIABLE 0x92E5 +#define GL_SHADER_STORAGE_BLOCK 0x92E6 +#define GL_VERTEX_SUBROUTINE 0x92E8 +#define GL_TESS_CONTROL_SUBROUTINE 0x92E9 +#define GL_TESS_EVALUATION_SUBROUTINE 0x92EA +#define GL_GEOMETRY_SUBROUTINE 0x92EB +#define GL_FRAGMENT_SUBROUTINE 0x92EC +#define GL_COMPUTE_SUBROUTINE 0x92ED +#define GL_VERTEX_SUBROUTINE_UNIFORM 0x92EE +#define GL_TESS_CONTROL_SUBROUTINE_UNIFORM 0x92EF +#define GL_TESS_EVALUATION_SUBROUTINE_UNIFORM 0x92F0 +#define GL_GEOMETRY_SUBROUTINE_UNIFORM 0x92F1 +#define GL_FRAGMENT_SUBROUTINE_UNIFORM 0x92F2 +#define GL_COMPUTE_SUBROUTINE_UNIFORM 0x92F3 +#define GL_TRANSFORM_FEEDBACK_VARYING 0x92F4 +#define GL_ACTIVE_RESOURCES 0x92F5 +#define GL_MAX_NAME_LENGTH 0x92F6 +#define GL_MAX_NUM_ACTIVE_VARIABLES 0x92F7 +#define GL_MAX_NUM_COMPATIBLE_SUBROUTINES 0x92F8 +#define GL_NAME_LENGTH 0x92F9 +#define GL_TYPE 0x92FA +#define GL_ARRAY_SIZE 0x92FB +#define GL_OFFSET 0x92FC +#define GL_BLOCK_INDEX 0x92FD +#define GL_ARRAY_STRIDE 0x92FE +#define GL_MATRIX_STRIDE 0x92FF +#define GL_IS_ROW_MAJOR 0x9300 +#define GL_ATOMIC_COUNTER_BUFFER_INDEX 0x9301 +#define GL_BUFFER_BINDING 0x9302 +#define GL_BUFFER_DATA_SIZE 0x9303 +#define GL_NUM_ACTIVE_VARIABLES 0x9304 +#define GL_ACTIVE_VARIABLES 0x9305 +#define GL_REFERENCED_BY_VERTEX_SHADER 0x9306 +#define GL_REFERENCED_BY_TESS_CONTROL_SHADER 0x9307 +#define GL_REFERENCED_BY_TESS_EVALUATION_SHADER 0x9308 +#define GL_REFERENCED_BY_GEOMETRY_SHADER 0x9309 +#define GL_REFERENCED_BY_FRAGMENT_SHADER 0x930A +#define GL_REFERENCED_BY_COMPUTE_SHADER 0x930B +#define GL_TOP_LEVEL_ARRAY_SIZE 0x930C +#define GL_TOP_LEVEL_ARRAY_STRIDE 0x930D +#define GL_LOCATION 0x930E +#define GL_LOCATION_INDEX 0x930F +#define GL_IS_PER_PATCH 0x92E7 +#define GL_SHADER_STORAGE_BUFFER 0x90D2 +#define GL_SHADER_STORAGE_BUFFER_BINDING 0x90D3 +#define GL_SHADER_STORAGE_BUFFER_START 0x90D4 +#define GL_SHADER_STORAGE_BUFFER_SIZE 0x90D5 +#define GL_MAX_VERTEX_SHADER_STORAGE_BLOCKS 0x90D6 +#define GL_MAX_GEOMETRY_SHADER_STORAGE_BLOCKS 0x90D7 +#define GL_MAX_TESS_CONTROL_SHADER_STORAGE_BLOCKS 0x90D8 +#define GL_MAX_TESS_EVALUATION_SHADER_STORAGE_BLOCKS 0x90D9 +#define GL_MAX_FRAGMENT_SHADER_STORAGE_BLOCKS 0x90DA +#define GL_MAX_COMPUTE_SHADER_STORAGE_BLOCKS 0x90DB +#define GL_MAX_COMBINED_SHADER_STORAGE_BLOCKS 0x90DC +#define GL_MAX_SHADER_STORAGE_BUFFER_BINDINGS 0x90DD +#define GL_MAX_SHADER_STORAGE_BLOCK_SIZE 0x90DE +#define GL_SHADER_STORAGE_BUFFER_OFFSET_ALIGNMENT 0x90DF +#define GL_SHADER_STORAGE_BARRIER_BIT 0x00002000 +#define GL_MAX_COMBINED_SHADER_OUTPUT_RESOURCES 0x8F39 +#define GL_DEPTH_STENCIL_TEXTURE_MODE 0x90EA +#define GL_TEXTURE_BUFFER_OFFSET 0x919D +#define GL_TEXTURE_BUFFER_SIZE 0x919E +#define GL_TEXTURE_BUFFER_OFFSET_ALIGNMENT 0x919F +#define GL_TEXTURE_VIEW_MIN_LEVEL 0x82DB +#define GL_TEXTURE_VIEW_NUM_LEVELS 0x82DC +#define GL_TEXTURE_VIEW_MIN_LAYER 0x82DD +#define GL_TEXTURE_VIEW_NUM_LAYERS 0x82DE +#define GL_TEXTURE_IMMUTABLE_LEVELS 0x82DF +#define GL_VERTEX_ATTRIB_BINDING 0x82D4 +#define GL_VERTEX_ATTRIB_RELATIVE_OFFSET 0x82D5 +#define GL_VERTEX_BINDING_DIVISOR 0x82D6 +#define GL_VERTEX_BINDING_OFFSET 0x82D7 +#define GL_VERTEX_BINDING_STRIDE 0x82D8 +#define GL_MAX_VERTEX_ATTRIB_RELATIVE_OFFSET 0x82D9 +#define GL_MAX_VERTEX_ATTRIB_BINDINGS 0x82DA +#define GL_VERTEX_BINDING_BUFFER 0x8F4F +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLCLEARBUFFERDATAPROC) (GLenum target, GLenum internalformat, GLenum format, GLenum type, const void *data); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLCLEARBUFFERSUBDATAPROC) (GLenum target, GLenum internalformat, GLintptr offset, GLsizeiptr size, GLenum format, GLenum type, const void *data); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDISPATCHCOMPUTEPROC) (GLuint num_groups_x, GLuint num_groups_y, GLuint num_groups_z); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDISPATCHCOMPUTEINDIRECTPROC) (GLintptr indirect); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLCOPYIMAGESUBDATAPROC) (GLuint srcName, GLenum srcTarget, GLint srcLevel, GLint srcX, GLint srcY, GLint srcZ, GLuint dstName, GLenum dstTarget, GLint dstLevel, GLint dstX, GLint dstY, GLint dstZ, GLsizei srcWidth, GLsizei srcHeight, GLsizei srcDepth); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLFRAMEBUFFERPARAMETERIPROC) (GLenum target, GLenum pname, GLint param); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETFRAMEBUFFERPARAMETERIVPROC) (GLenum target, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETINTERNALFORMATI64VPROC) (GLenum target, GLenum internalformat, GLenum pname, GLsizei bufSize, GLint64 *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLINVALIDATETEXSUBIMAGEPROC) (GLuint texture, GLint level, GLint xoffset, GLint yoffset, GLint zoffset, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLsizei depth); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLINVALIDATETEXIMAGEPROC) (GLuint texture, GLint level); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLINVALIDATEBUFFERSUBDATAPROC) (GLuint buffer, GLintptr offset, GLsizeiptr length); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLINVALIDATEBUFFERDATAPROC) (GLuint buffer); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLINVALIDATEFRAMEBUFFERPROC) (GLenum target, GLsizei numAttachments, const GLenum *attachments); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLINVALIDATESUBFRAMEBUFFERPROC) (GLenum target, GLsizei numAttachments, const GLenum *attachments, GLint x, GLint y, GLsizei width, GLsizei height); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLMULTIDRAWARRAYSINDIRECTPROC) (GLenum mode, const void *indirect, GLsizei drawcount, GLsizei stride); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLMULTIDRAWELEMENTSINDIRECTPROC) (GLenum mode, GLenum type, const void *indirect, GLsizei drawcount, GLsizei stride); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETPROGRAMINTERFACEIVPROC) (GLuint program, GLenum programInterface, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +typedef GLuint (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETPROGRAMRESOURCEINDEXPROC) (GLuint program, GLenum programInterface, const GLchar *name); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETPROGRAMRESOURCENAMEPROC) (GLuint program, GLenum programInterface, GLuint index, GLsizei bufSize, GLsizei *length, GLchar *name); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETPROGRAMRESOURCEIVPROC) (GLuint program, GLenum programInterface, GLuint index, GLsizei propCount, const GLenum *props, GLsizei bufSize, GLsizei *length, GLint *params); +typedef GLint (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETPROGRAMRESOURCELOCATIONPROC) (GLuint program, GLenum programInterface, const GLchar *name); +typedef GLint (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETPROGRAMRESOURCELOCATIONINDEXPROC) (GLuint program, GLenum programInterface, const GLchar *name); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLSHADERSTORAGEBLOCKBINDINGPROC) (GLuint program, GLuint storageBlockIndex, GLuint storageBlockBinding); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLTEXBUFFERRANGEPROC) (GLenum target, GLenum internalformat, GLuint buffer, GLintptr offset, GLsizeiptr size); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLTEXSTORAGE2DMULTISAMPLEPROC) (GLenum target, GLsizei samples, GLenum internalformat, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLboolean fixedsamplelocations); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLTEXSTORAGE3DMULTISAMPLEPROC) (GLenum target, GLsizei samples, GLenum internalformat, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLsizei depth, GLboolean fixedsamplelocations); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLTEXTUREVIEWPROC) (GLuint texture, GLenum target, GLuint origtexture, GLenum internalformat, GLuint minlevel, GLuint numlevels, GLuint minlayer, GLuint numlayers); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLBINDVERTEXBUFFERPROC) (GLuint bindingindex, GLuint buffer, GLintptr offset, GLsizei stride); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBFORMATPROC) (GLuint attribindex, GLint size, GLenum type, GLboolean normalized, GLuint relativeoffset); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBIFORMATPROC) (GLuint attribindex, GLint size, GLenum type, GLuint relativeoffset); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBLFORMATPROC) (GLuint attribindex, GLint size, GLenum type, GLuint relativeoffset); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBBINDINGPROC) (GLuint attribindex, GLuint bindingindex); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXBINDINGDIVISORPROC) (GLuint bindingindex, GLuint divisor); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDEBUGMESSAGECONTROLPROC) (GLenum source, GLenum type, GLenum severity, GLsizei count, const GLuint *ids, GLboolean enabled); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDEBUGMESSAGEINSERTPROC) (GLenum source, GLenum type, GLuint id, GLenum severity, GLsizei length, const GLchar *buf); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDEBUGMESSAGECALLBACKPROC) (GLDEBUGPROC callback, const void *userParam); +typedef GLuint (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETDEBUGMESSAGELOGPROC) (GLuint count, GLsizei bufSize, GLenum *sources, GLenum *types, GLuint *ids, GLenum *severities, GLsizei *lengths, GLchar *messageLog); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPUSHDEBUGGROUPPROC) (GLenum source, GLuint id, GLsizei length, const GLchar *message); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPOPDEBUGGROUPPROC) (void); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLOBJECTLABELPROC) (GLenum identifier, GLuint name, GLsizei length, const GLchar *label); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETOBJECTLABELPROC) (GLenum identifier, GLuint name, GLsizei bufSize, GLsizei *length, GLchar *label); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLOBJECTPTRLABELPROC) (const void *ptr, GLsizei length, const GLchar *label); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETOBJECTPTRLABELPROC) (const void *ptr, GLsizei bufSize, GLsizei *length, GLchar *label); +#ifdef GL_GLEXT_PROTOTYPES +GLAPI void APIENTRY glClearBufferData (GLenum target, GLenum internalformat, GLenum format, GLenum type, const void *data); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glClearBufferSubData (GLenum target, GLenum internalformat, GLintptr offset, GLsizeiptr size, GLenum format, GLenum type, const void *data); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDispatchCompute (GLuint num_groups_x, GLuint num_groups_y, GLuint num_groups_z); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDispatchComputeIndirect (GLintptr indirect); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glCopyImageSubData (GLuint srcName, GLenum srcTarget, GLint srcLevel, GLint srcX, GLint srcY, GLint srcZ, GLuint dstName, GLenum dstTarget, GLint dstLevel, GLint dstX, GLint dstY, GLint dstZ, GLsizei srcWidth, GLsizei srcHeight, GLsizei srcDepth); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glFramebufferParameteri (GLenum target, GLenum pname, GLint param); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetFramebufferParameteriv (GLenum target, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetInternalformati64v (GLenum target, GLenum internalformat, GLenum pname, GLsizei bufSize, GLint64 *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glInvalidateTexSubImage (GLuint texture, GLint level, GLint xoffset, GLint yoffset, GLint zoffset, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLsizei depth); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glInvalidateTexImage (GLuint texture, GLint level); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glInvalidateBufferSubData (GLuint buffer, GLintptr offset, GLsizeiptr length); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glInvalidateBufferData (GLuint buffer); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glInvalidateFramebuffer (GLenum target, GLsizei numAttachments, const GLenum *attachments); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glInvalidateSubFramebuffer (GLenum target, GLsizei numAttachments, const GLenum *attachments, GLint x, GLint y, GLsizei width, GLsizei height); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glMultiDrawArraysIndirect (GLenum mode, const void *indirect, GLsizei drawcount, GLsizei stride); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glMultiDrawElementsIndirect (GLenum mode, GLenum type, const void *indirect, GLsizei drawcount, GLsizei stride); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetProgramInterfaceiv (GLuint program, GLenum programInterface, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +GLAPI GLuint APIENTRY glGetProgramResourceIndex (GLuint program, GLenum programInterface, const GLchar *name); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetProgramResourceName (GLuint program, GLenum programInterface, GLuint index, GLsizei bufSize, GLsizei *length, GLchar *name); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetProgramResourceiv (GLuint program, GLenum programInterface, GLuint index, GLsizei propCount, const GLenum *props, GLsizei bufSize, GLsizei *length, GLint *params); +GLAPI GLint APIENTRY glGetProgramResourceLocation (GLuint program, GLenum programInterface, const GLchar *name); +GLAPI GLint APIENTRY glGetProgramResourceLocationIndex (GLuint program, GLenum programInterface, const GLchar *name); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glShaderStorageBlockBinding (GLuint program, GLuint storageBlockIndex, GLuint storageBlockBinding); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glTexBufferRange (GLenum target, GLenum internalformat, GLuint buffer, GLintptr offset, GLsizeiptr size); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glTexStorage2DMultisample (GLenum target, GLsizei samples, GLenum internalformat, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLboolean fixedsamplelocations); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glTexStorage3DMultisample (GLenum target, GLsizei samples, GLenum internalformat, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLsizei depth, GLboolean fixedsamplelocations); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glTextureView (GLuint texture, GLenum target, GLuint origtexture, GLenum internalformat, GLuint minlevel, GLuint numlevels, GLuint minlayer, GLuint numlayers); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glBindVertexBuffer (GLuint bindingindex, GLuint buffer, GLintptr offset, GLsizei stride); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttribFormat (GLuint attribindex, GLint size, GLenum type, GLboolean normalized, GLuint relativeoffset); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttribIFormat (GLuint attribindex, GLint size, GLenum type, GLuint relativeoffset); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttribLFormat (GLuint attribindex, GLint size, GLenum type, GLuint relativeoffset); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttribBinding (GLuint attribindex, GLuint bindingindex); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexBindingDivisor (GLuint bindingindex, GLuint divisor); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDebugMessageControl (GLenum source, GLenum type, GLenum severity, GLsizei count, const GLuint *ids, GLboolean enabled); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDebugMessageInsert (GLenum source, GLenum type, GLuint id, GLenum severity, GLsizei length, const GLchar *buf); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDebugMessageCallback (GLDEBUGPROC callback, const void *userParam); +GLAPI GLuint APIENTRY glGetDebugMessageLog (GLuint count, GLsizei bufSize, GLenum *sources, GLenum *types, GLuint *ids, GLenum *severities, GLsizei *lengths, GLchar *messageLog); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glPushDebugGroup (GLenum source, GLuint id, GLsizei length, const GLchar *message); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glPopDebugGroup (void); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glObjectLabel (GLenum identifier, GLuint name, GLsizei length, const GLchar *label); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetObjectLabel (GLenum identifier, GLuint name, GLsizei bufSize, GLsizei *length, GLchar *label); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glObjectPtrLabel (const void *ptr, GLsizei length, const GLchar *label); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetObjectPtrLabel (const void *ptr, GLsizei bufSize, GLsizei *length, GLchar *label); +#endif +#endif /* GL_VERSION_4_3 */ + +#ifndef GL_VERSION_4_4 +#define GL_VERSION_4_4 1 +#define GL_MAX_VERTEX_ATTRIB_STRIDE 0x82E5 +#define GL_PRIMITIVE_RESTART_FOR_PATCHES_SUPPORTED 0x8221 +#define GL_TEXTURE_BUFFER_BINDING 0x8C2A +#define GL_MAP_PERSISTENT_BIT 0x0040 +#define GL_MAP_COHERENT_BIT 0x0080 +#define GL_DYNAMIC_STORAGE_BIT 0x0100 +#define GL_CLIENT_STORAGE_BIT 0x0200 +#define GL_CLIENT_MAPPED_BUFFER_BARRIER_BIT 0x00004000 +#define GL_BUFFER_IMMUTABLE_STORAGE 0x821F +#define GL_BUFFER_STORAGE_FLAGS 0x8220 +#define GL_CLEAR_TEXTURE 0x9365 +#define GL_LOCATION_COMPONENT 0x934A +#define GL_TRANSFORM_FEEDBACK_BUFFER_INDEX 0x934B +#define GL_TRANSFORM_FEEDBACK_BUFFER_STRIDE 0x934C +#define GL_QUERY_BUFFER 0x9192 +#define GL_QUERY_BUFFER_BARRIER_BIT 0x00008000 +#define GL_QUERY_BUFFER_BINDING 0x9193 +#define GL_QUERY_RESULT_NO_WAIT 0x9194 +#define GL_MIRROR_CLAMP_TO_EDGE 0x8743 +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLBUFFERSTORAGEPROC) (GLenum target, GLsizeiptr size, const void *data, GLbitfield flags); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLCLEARTEXIMAGEPROC) (GLuint texture, GLint level, GLenum format, GLenum type, const void *data); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLCLEARTEXSUBIMAGEPROC) (GLuint texture, GLint level, GLint xoffset, GLint yoffset, GLint zoffset, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLsizei depth, GLenum format, GLenum type, const void *data); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLBINDBUFFERSBASEPROC) (GLenum target, GLuint first, GLsizei count, const GLuint *buffers); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLBINDBUFFERSRANGEPROC) (GLenum target, GLuint first, GLsizei count, const GLuint *buffers, const GLintptr *offsets, const GLsizeiptr *sizes); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLBINDTEXTURESPROC) (GLuint first, GLsizei count, const GLuint *textures); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLBINDSAMPLERSPROC) (GLuint first, GLsizei count, const GLuint *samplers); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLBINDIMAGETEXTURESPROC) (GLuint first, GLsizei count, const GLuint *textures); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLBINDVERTEXBUFFERSPROC) (GLuint first, GLsizei count, const GLuint *buffers, const GLintptr *offsets, const GLsizei *strides); +#ifdef GL_GLEXT_PROTOTYPES +GLAPI void APIENTRY glBufferStorage (GLenum target, GLsizeiptr size, const void *data, GLbitfield flags); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glClearTexImage (GLuint texture, GLint level, GLenum format, GLenum type, const void *data); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glClearTexSubImage (GLuint texture, GLint level, GLint xoffset, GLint yoffset, GLint zoffset, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLsizei depth, GLenum format, GLenum type, const void *data); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glBindBuffersBase (GLenum target, GLuint first, GLsizei count, const GLuint *buffers); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glBindBuffersRange (GLenum target, GLuint first, GLsizei count, const GLuint *buffers, const GLintptr *offsets, const GLsizeiptr *sizes); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glBindTextures (GLuint first, GLsizei count, const GLuint *textures); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glBindSamplers (GLuint first, GLsizei count, const GLuint *samplers); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glBindImageTextures (GLuint first, GLsizei count, const GLuint *textures); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glBindVertexBuffers (GLuint first, GLsizei count, const GLuint *buffers, const GLintptr *offsets, const GLsizei *strides); +#endif +#endif /* GL_VERSION_4_4 */ + +#ifndef GL_VERSION_4_5 +#define GL_VERSION_4_5 1 +#define GL_CONTEXT_LOST 0x0507 +#define GL_NEGATIVE_ONE_TO_ONE 0x935E +#define GL_ZERO_TO_ONE 0x935F +#define GL_CLIP_ORIGIN 0x935C +#define GL_CLIP_DEPTH_MODE 0x935D +#define GL_QUERY_WAIT_INVERTED 0x8E17 +#define GL_QUERY_NO_WAIT_INVERTED 0x8E18 +#define GL_QUERY_BY_REGION_WAIT_INVERTED 0x8E19 +#define GL_QUERY_BY_REGION_NO_WAIT_INVERTED 0x8E1A +#define GL_MAX_CULL_DISTANCES 0x82F9 +#define GL_MAX_COMBINED_CLIP_AND_CULL_DISTANCES 0x82FA +#define GL_TEXTURE_TARGET 0x1006 +#define GL_QUERY_TARGET 0x82EA +#define GL_GUILTY_CONTEXT_RESET 0x8253 +#define GL_INNOCENT_CONTEXT_RESET 0x8254 +#define GL_UNKNOWN_CONTEXT_RESET 0x8255 +#define GL_RESET_NOTIFICATION_STRATEGY 0x8256 +#define GL_LOSE_CONTEXT_ON_RESET 0x8252 +#define GL_NO_RESET_NOTIFICATION 0x8261 +#define GL_CONTEXT_FLAG_ROBUST_ACCESS_BIT 0x00000004 +#define GL_CONTEXT_RELEASE_BEHAVIOR 0x82FB +#define GL_CONTEXT_RELEASE_BEHAVIOR_FLUSH 0x82FC +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLCLIPCONTROLPROC) (GLenum origin, GLenum depth); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLCREATETRANSFORMFEEDBACKSPROC) (GLsizei n, GLuint *ids); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLTRANSFORMFEEDBACKBUFFERBASEPROC) (GLuint xfb, GLuint index, GLuint buffer); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLTRANSFORMFEEDBACKBUFFERRANGEPROC) (GLuint xfb, GLuint index, GLuint buffer, GLintptr offset, GLsizeiptr size); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETTRANSFORMFEEDBACKIVPROC) (GLuint xfb, GLenum pname, GLint *param); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETTRANSFORMFEEDBACKI_VPROC) (GLuint xfb, GLenum pname, GLuint index, GLint *param); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETTRANSFORMFEEDBACKI64_VPROC) (GLuint xfb, GLenum pname, GLuint index, GLint64 *param); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLCREATEBUFFERSPROC) (GLsizei n, GLuint *buffers); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLNAMEDBUFFERSTORAGEPROC) (GLuint buffer, GLsizeiptr size, const void *data, GLbitfield flags); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLNAMEDBUFFERDATAPROC) (GLuint buffer, GLsizeiptr size, const void *data, GLenum usage); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLNAMEDBUFFERSUBDATAPROC) (GLuint buffer, GLintptr offset, GLsizeiptr size, const void *data); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLCOPYNAMEDBUFFERSUBDATAPROC) (GLuint readBuffer, GLuint writeBuffer, GLintptr readOffset, GLintptr writeOffset, GLsizeiptr size); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLCLEARNAMEDBUFFERDATAPROC) (GLuint buffer, GLenum internalformat, GLenum format, GLenum type, const void *data); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLCLEARNAMEDBUFFERSUBDATAPROC) (GLuint buffer, GLenum internalformat, GLintptr offset, GLsizeiptr size, GLenum format, GLenum type, const void *data); +typedef void *(APIENTRYP PFNGLMAPNAMEDBUFFERPROC) (GLuint buffer, GLenum access); +typedef void *(APIENTRYP PFNGLMAPNAMEDBUFFERRANGEPROC) (GLuint buffer, GLintptr offset, GLsizeiptr length, GLbitfield access); +typedef GLboolean (APIENTRYP PFNGLUNMAPNAMEDBUFFERPROC) (GLuint buffer); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLFLUSHMAPPEDNAMEDBUFFERRANGEPROC) (GLuint buffer, GLintptr offset, GLsizeiptr length); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETNAMEDBUFFERPARAMETERIVPROC) (GLuint buffer, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETNAMEDBUFFERPARAMETERI64VPROC) (GLuint buffer, GLenum pname, GLint64 *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETNAMEDBUFFERPOINTERVPROC) (GLuint buffer, GLenum pname, void **params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETNAMEDBUFFERSUBDATAPROC) (GLuint buffer, GLintptr offset, GLsizeiptr size, void *data); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLCREATEFRAMEBUFFERSPROC) (GLsizei n, GLuint *framebuffers); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERRENDERBUFFERPROC) (GLuint framebuffer, GLenum attachment, GLenum renderbuffertarget, GLuint renderbuffer); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERPARAMETERIPROC) (GLuint framebuffer, GLenum pname, GLint param); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERTEXTUREPROC) (GLuint framebuffer, GLenum attachment, GLuint texture, GLint level); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERTEXTURELAYERPROC) (GLuint framebuffer, GLenum attachment, GLuint texture, GLint level, GLint layer); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERDRAWBUFFERPROC) (GLuint framebuffer, GLenum buf); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERDRAWBUFFERSPROC) (GLuint framebuffer, GLsizei n, const GLenum *bufs); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERREADBUFFERPROC) (GLuint framebuffer, GLenum src); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLINVALIDATENAMEDFRAMEBUFFERDATAPROC) (GLuint framebuffer, GLsizei numAttachments, const GLenum *attachments); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLINVALIDATENAMEDFRAMEBUFFERSUBDATAPROC) (GLuint framebuffer, GLsizei numAttachments, const GLenum *attachments, GLint x, GLint y, GLsizei width, GLsizei height); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLCLEARNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERIVPROC) (GLuint framebuffer, GLenum buffer, GLint drawbuffer, const GLint *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLCLEARNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERUIVPROC) (GLuint framebuffer, GLenum buffer, GLint drawbuffer, const GLuint *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLCLEARNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERFVPROC) (GLuint framebuffer, GLenum buffer, GLint drawbuffer, const GLfloat *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLCLEARNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERFIPROC) (GLuint framebuffer, GLenum buffer, GLint drawbuffer, GLfloat depth, GLint stencil); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLBLITNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERPROC) (GLuint readFramebuffer, GLuint drawFramebuffer, GLint srcX0, GLint srcY0, GLint srcX1, GLint srcY1, GLint dstX0, GLint dstY0, GLint dstX1, GLint dstY1, GLbitfield mask, GLenum filter); +typedef GLenum (APIENTRYP PFNGLCHECKNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERSTATUSPROC) (GLuint framebuffer, GLenum target); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERPARAMETERIVPROC) (GLuint framebuffer, GLenum pname, GLint *param); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERATTACHMENTPARAMETERIVPROC) (GLuint framebuffer, GLenum attachment, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLCREATERENDERBUFFERSPROC) (GLsizei n, GLuint *renderbuffers); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLNAMEDRENDERBUFFERSTORAGEPROC) (GLuint renderbuffer, GLenum internalformat, GLsizei width, GLsizei height); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLNAMEDRENDERBUFFERSTORAGEMULTISAMPLEPROC) (GLuint renderbuffer, GLsizei samples, GLenum internalformat, GLsizei width, GLsizei height); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETNAMEDRENDERBUFFERPARAMETERIVPROC) (GLuint renderbuffer, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLCREATETEXTURESPROC) (GLenum target, GLsizei n, GLuint *textures); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLTEXTUREBUFFERPROC) (GLuint texture, GLenum internalformat, GLuint buffer); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLTEXTUREBUFFERRANGEPROC) (GLuint texture, GLenum internalformat, GLuint buffer, GLintptr offset, GLsizeiptr size); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLTEXTURESTORAGE1DPROC) (GLuint texture, GLsizei levels, GLenum internalformat, GLsizei width); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLTEXTURESTORAGE2DPROC) (GLuint texture, GLsizei levels, GLenum internalformat, GLsizei width, GLsizei height); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLTEXTURESTORAGE3DPROC) (GLuint texture, GLsizei levels, GLenum internalformat, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLsizei depth); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLTEXTURESTORAGE2DMULTISAMPLEPROC) (GLuint texture, GLsizei samples, GLenum internalformat, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLboolean fixedsamplelocations); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLTEXTURESTORAGE3DMULTISAMPLEPROC) (GLuint texture, GLsizei samples, GLenum internalformat, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLsizei depth, GLboolean fixedsamplelocations); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLTEXTURESUBIMAGE1DPROC) (GLuint texture, GLint level, GLint xoffset, GLsizei width, GLenum format, GLenum type, const void *pixels); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLTEXTURESUBIMAGE2DPROC) (GLuint texture, GLint level, GLint xoffset, GLint yoffset, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLenum format, GLenum type, const void *pixels); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLTEXTURESUBIMAGE3DPROC) (GLuint texture, GLint level, GLint xoffset, GLint yoffset, GLint zoffset, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLsizei depth, GLenum format, GLenum type, const void *pixels); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLCOMPRESSEDTEXTURESUBIMAGE1DPROC) (GLuint texture, GLint level, GLint xoffset, GLsizei width, GLenum format, GLsizei imageSize, const void *data); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLCOMPRESSEDTEXTURESUBIMAGE2DPROC) (GLuint texture, GLint level, GLint xoffset, GLint yoffset, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLenum format, GLsizei imageSize, const void *data); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLCOMPRESSEDTEXTURESUBIMAGE3DPROC) (GLuint texture, GLint level, GLint xoffset, GLint yoffset, GLint zoffset, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLsizei depth, GLenum format, GLsizei imageSize, const void *data); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLCOPYTEXTURESUBIMAGE1DPROC) (GLuint texture, GLint level, GLint xoffset, GLint x, GLint y, GLsizei width); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLCOPYTEXTURESUBIMAGE2DPROC) (GLuint texture, GLint level, GLint xoffset, GLint yoffset, GLint x, GLint y, GLsizei width, GLsizei height); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLCOPYTEXTURESUBIMAGE3DPROC) (GLuint texture, GLint level, GLint xoffset, GLint yoffset, GLint zoffset, GLint x, GLint y, GLsizei width, GLsizei height); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLTEXTUREPARAMETERFPROC) (GLuint texture, GLenum pname, GLfloat param); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLTEXTUREPARAMETERFVPROC) (GLuint texture, GLenum pname, const GLfloat *param); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLTEXTUREPARAMETERIPROC) (GLuint texture, GLenum pname, GLint param); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLTEXTUREPARAMETERIIVPROC) (GLuint texture, GLenum pname, const GLint *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLTEXTUREPARAMETERIUIVPROC) (GLuint texture, GLenum pname, const GLuint *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLTEXTUREPARAMETERIVPROC) (GLuint texture, GLenum pname, const GLint *param); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGENERATETEXTUREMIPMAPPROC) (GLuint texture); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLBINDTEXTUREUNITPROC) (GLuint unit, GLuint texture); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETTEXTUREIMAGEPROC) (GLuint texture, GLint level, GLenum format, GLenum type, GLsizei bufSize, void *pixels); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETCOMPRESSEDTEXTUREIMAGEPROC) (GLuint texture, GLint level, GLsizei bufSize, void *pixels); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETTEXTURELEVELPARAMETERFVPROC) (GLuint texture, GLint level, GLenum pname, GLfloat *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETTEXTURELEVELPARAMETERIVPROC) (GLuint texture, GLint level, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETTEXTUREPARAMETERFVPROC) (GLuint texture, GLenum pname, GLfloat *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETTEXTUREPARAMETERIIVPROC) (GLuint texture, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETTEXTUREPARAMETERIUIVPROC) (GLuint texture, GLenum pname, GLuint *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETTEXTUREPARAMETERIVPROC) (GLuint texture, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLCREATEVERTEXARRAYSPROC) (GLsizei n, GLuint *arrays); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDISABLEVERTEXARRAYATTRIBPROC) (GLuint vaobj, GLuint index); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLENABLEVERTEXARRAYATTRIBPROC) (GLuint vaobj, GLuint index); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXARRAYELEMENTBUFFERPROC) (GLuint vaobj, GLuint buffer); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXARRAYVERTEXBUFFERPROC) (GLuint vaobj, GLuint bindingindex, GLuint buffer, GLintptr offset, GLsizei stride); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXARRAYVERTEXBUFFERSPROC) (GLuint vaobj, GLuint first, GLsizei count, const GLuint *buffers, const GLintptr *offsets, const GLsizei *strides); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXARRAYATTRIBBINDINGPROC) (GLuint vaobj, GLuint attribindex, GLuint bindingindex); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXARRAYATTRIBFORMATPROC) (GLuint vaobj, GLuint attribindex, GLint size, GLenum type, GLboolean normalized, GLuint relativeoffset); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXARRAYATTRIBIFORMATPROC) (GLuint vaobj, GLuint attribindex, GLint size, GLenum type, GLuint relativeoffset); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXARRAYATTRIBLFORMATPROC) (GLuint vaobj, GLuint attribindex, GLint size, GLenum type, GLuint relativeoffset); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXARRAYBINDINGDIVISORPROC) (GLuint vaobj, GLuint bindingindex, GLuint divisor); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETVERTEXARRAYIVPROC) (GLuint vaobj, GLenum pname, GLint *param); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETVERTEXARRAYINDEXEDIVPROC) (GLuint vaobj, GLuint index, GLenum pname, GLint *param); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETVERTEXARRAYINDEXED64IVPROC) (GLuint vaobj, GLuint index, GLenum pname, GLint64 *param); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLCREATESAMPLERSPROC) (GLsizei n, GLuint *samplers); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLCREATEPROGRAMPIPELINESPROC) (GLsizei n, GLuint *pipelines); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLCREATEQUERIESPROC) (GLenum target, GLsizei n, GLuint *ids); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETQUERYBUFFEROBJECTI64VPROC) (GLuint id, GLuint buffer, GLenum pname, GLintptr offset); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETQUERYBUFFEROBJECTIVPROC) (GLuint id, GLuint buffer, GLenum pname, GLintptr offset); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETQUERYBUFFEROBJECTUI64VPROC) (GLuint id, GLuint buffer, GLenum pname, GLintptr offset); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETQUERYBUFFEROBJECTUIVPROC) (GLuint id, GLuint buffer, GLenum pname, GLintptr offset); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLMEMORYBARRIERBYREGIONPROC) (GLbitfield barriers); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETTEXTURESUBIMAGEPROC) (GLuint texture, GLint level, GLint xoffset, GLint yoffset, GLint zoffset, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLsizei depth, GLenum format, GLenum type, GLsizei bufSize, void *pixels); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETCOMPRESSEDTEXTURESUBIMAGEPROC) (GLuint texture, GLint level, GLint xoffset, GLint yoffset, GLint zoffset, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLsizei depth, GLsizei bufSize, void *pixels); +typedef GLenum (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETGRAPHICSRESETSTATUSPROC) (void); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETNCOMPRESSEDTEXIMAGEPROC) (GLenum target, GLint lod, GLsizei bufSize, void *pixels); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETNTEXIMAGEPROC) (GLenum target, GLint level, GLenum format, GLenum type, GLsizei bufSize, void *pixels); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETNUNIFORMDVPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei bufSize, GLdouble *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETNUNIFORMFVPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei bufSize, GLfloat *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETNUNIFORMIVPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei bufSize, GLint *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETNUNIFORMUIVPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei bufSize, GLuint *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLREADNPIXELSPROC) (GLint x, GLint y, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLenum format, GLenum type, GLsizei bufSize, void *data); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLTEXTUREBARRIERPROC) (void); +#ifdef GL_GLEXT_PROTOTYPES +GLAPI void APIENTRY glClipControl (GLenum origin, GLenum depth); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glCreateTransformFeedbacks (GLsizei n, GLuint *ids); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glTransformFeedbackBufferBase (GLuint xfb, GLuint index, GLuint buffer); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glTransformFeedbackBufferRange (GLuint xfb, GLuint index, GLuint buffer, GLintptr offset, GLsizeiptr size); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetTransformFeedbackiv (GLuint xfb, GLenum pname, GLint *param); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetTransformFeedbacki_v (GLuint xfb, GLenum pname, GLuint index, GLint *param); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetTransformFeedbacki64_v (GLuint xfb, GLenum pname, GLuint index, GLint64 *param); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glCreateBuffers (GLsizei n, GLuint *buffers); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glNamedBufferStorage (GLuint buffer, GLsizeiptr size, const void *data, GLbitfield flags); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glNamedBufferData (GLuint buffer, GLsizeiptr size, const void *data, GLenum usage); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glNamedBufferSubData (GLuint buffer, GLintptr offset, GLsizeiptr size, const void *data); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glCopyNamedBufferSubData (GLuint readBuffer, GLuint writeBuffer, GLintptr readOffset, GLintptr writeOffset, GLsizeiptr size); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glClearNamedBufferData (GLuint buffer, GLenum internalformat, GLenum format, GLenum type, const void *data); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glClearNamedBufferSubData (GLuint buffer, GLenum internalformat, GLintptr offset, GLsizeiptr size, GLenum format, GLenum type, const void *data); +GLAPI void *APIENTRY glMapNamedBuffer (GLuint buffer, GLenum access); +GLAPI void *APIENTRY glMapNamedBufferRange (GLuint buffer, GLintptr offset, GLsizeiptr length, GLbitfield access); +GLAPI GLboolean APIENTRY glUnmapNamedBuffer (GLuint buffer); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glFlushMappedNamedBufferRange (GLuint buffer, GLintptr offset, GLsizeiptr length); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetNamedBufferParameteriv (GLuint buffer, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetNamedBufferParameteri64v (GLuint buffer, GLenum pname, GLint64 *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetNamedBufferPointerv (GLuint buffer, GLenum pname, void **params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetNamedBufferSubData (GLuint buffer, GLintptr offset, GLsizeiptr size, void *data); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glCreateFramebuffers (GLsizei n, GLuint *framebuffers); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glNamedFramebufferRenderbuffer (GLuint framebuffer, GLenum attachment, GLenum renderbuffertarget, GLuint renderbuffer); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glNamedFramebufferParameteri (GLuint framebuffer, GLenum pname, GLint param); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glNamedFramebufferTexture (GLuint framebuffer, GLenum attachment, GLuint texture, GLint level); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glNamedFramebufferTextureLayer (GLuint framebuffer, GLenum attachment, GLuint texture, GLint level, GLint layer); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glNamedFramebufferDrawBuffer (GLuint framebuffer, GLenum buf); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glNamedFramebufferDrawBuffers (GLuint framebuffer, GLsizei n, const GLenum *bufs); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glNamedFramebufferReadBuffer (GLuint framebuffer, GLenum src); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glInvalidateNamedFramebufferData (GLuint framebuffer, GLsizei numAttachments, const GLenum *attachments); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glInvalidateNamedFramebufferSubData (GLuint framebuffer, GLsizei numAttachments, const GLenum *attachments, GLint x, GLint y, GLsizei width, GLsizei height); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glClearNamedFramebufferiv (GLuint framebuffer, GLenum buffer, GLint drawbuffer, const GLint *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glClearNamedFramebufferuiv (GLuint framebuffer, GLenum buffer, GLint drawbuffer, const GLuint *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glClearNamedFramebufferfv (GLuint framebuffer, GLenum buffer, GLint drawbuffer, const GLfloat *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glClearNamedFramebufferfi (GLuint framebuffer, GLenum buffer, GLint drawbuffer, GLfloat depth, GLint stencil); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glBlitNamedFramebuffer (GLuint readFramebuffer, GLuint drawFramebuffer, GLint srcX0, GLint srcY0, GLint srcX1, GLint srcY1, GLint dstX0, GLint dstY0, GLint dstX1, GLint dstY1, GLbitfield mask, GLenum filter); +GLAPI GLenum APIENTRY glCheckNamedFramebufferStatus (GLuint framebuffer, GLenum target); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetNamedFramebufferParameteriv (GLuint framebuffer, GLenum pname, GLint *param); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetNamedFramebufferAttachmentParameteriv (GLuint framebuffer, GLenum attachment, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glCreateRenderbuffers (GLsizei n, GLuint *renderbuffers); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glNamedRenderbufferStorage (GLuint renderbuffer, GLenum internalformat, GLsizei width, GLsizei height); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glNamedRenderbufferStorageMultisample (GLuint renderbuffer, GLsizei samples, GLenum internalformat, GLsizei width, GLsizei height); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetNamedRenderbufferParameteriv (GLuint renderbuffer, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glCreateTextures (GLenum target, GLsizei n, GLuint *textures); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glTextureBuffer (GLuint texture, GLenum internalformat, GLuint buffer); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glTextureBufferRange (GLuint texture, GLenum internalformat, GLuint buffer, GLintptr offset, GLsizeiptr size); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glTextureStorage1D (GLuint texture, GLsizei levels, GLenum internalformat, GLsizei width); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glTextureStorage2D (GLuint texture, GLsizei levels, GLenum internalformat, GLsizei width, GLsizei height); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glTextureStorage3D (GLuint texture, GLsizei levels, GLenum internalformat, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLsizei depth); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glTextureStorage2DMultisample (GLuint texture, GLsizei samples, GLenum internalformat, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLboolean fixedsamplelocations); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glTextureStorage3DMultisample (GLuint texture, GLsizei samples, GLenum internalformat, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLsizei depth, GLboolean fixedsamplelocations); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glTextureSubImage1D (GLuint texture, GLint level, GLint xoffset, GLsizei width, GLenum format, GLenum type, const void *pixels); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glTextureSubImage2D (GLuint texture, GLint level, GLint xoffset, GLint yoffset, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLenum format, GLenum type, const void *pixels); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glTextureSubImage3D (GLuint texture, GLint level, GLint xoffset, GLint yoffset, GLint zoffset, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLsizei depth, GLenum format, GLenum type, const void *pixels); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glCompressedTextureSubImage1D (GLuint texture, GLint level, GLint xoffset, GLsizei width, GLenum format, GLsizei imageSize, const void *data); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glCompressedTextureSubImage2D (GLuint texture, GLint level, GLint xoffset, GLint yoffset, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLenum format, GLsizei imageSize, const void *data); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glCompressedTextureSubImage3D (GLuint texture, GLint level, GLint xoffset, GLint yoffset, GLint zoffset, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLsizei depth, GLenum format, GLsizei imageSize, const void *data); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glCopyTextureSubImage1D (GLuint texture, GLint level, GLint xoffset, GLint x, GLint y, GLsizei width); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glCopyTextureSubImage2D (GLuint texture, GLint level, GLint xoffset, GLint yoffset, GLint x, GLint y, GLsizei width, GLsizei height); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glCopyTextureSubImage3D (GLuint texture, GLint level, GLint xoffset, GLint yoffset, GLint zoffset, GLint x, GLint y, GLsizei width, GLsizei height); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glTextureParameterf (GLuint texture, GLenum pname, GLfloat param); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glTextureParameterfv (GLuint texture, GLenum pname, const GLfloat *param); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glTextureParameteri (GLuint texture, GLenum pname, GLint param); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glTextureParameterIiv (GLuint texture, GLenum pname, const GLint *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glTextureParameterIuiv (GLuint texture, GLenum pname, const GLuint *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glTextureParameteriv (GLuint texture, GLenum pname, const GLint *param); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGenerateTextureMipmap (GLuint texture); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glBindTextureUnit (GLuint unit, GLuint texture); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetTextureImage (GLuint texture, GLint level, GLenum format, GLenum type, GLsizei bufSize, void *pixels); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetCompressedTextureImage (GLuint texture, GLint level, GLsizei bufSize, void *pixels); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetTextureLevelParameterfv (GLuint texture, GLint level, GLenum pname, GLfloat *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetTextureLevelParameteriv (GLuint texture, GLint level, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetTextureParameterfv (GLuint texture, GLenum pname, GLfloat *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetTextureParameterIiv (GLuint texture, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetTextureParameterIuiv (GLuint texture, GLenum pname, GLuint *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetTextureParameteriv (GLuint texture, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glCreateVertexArrays (GLsizei n, GLuint *arrays); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDisableVertexArrayAttrib (GLuint vaobj, GLuint index); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glEnableVertexArrayAttrib (GLuint vaobj, GLuint index); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexArrayElementBuffer (GLuint vaobj, GLuint buffer); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexArrayVertexBuffer (GLuint vaobj, GLuint bindingindex, GLuint buffer, GLintptr offset, GLsizei stride); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexArrayVertexBuffers (GLuint vaobj, GLuint first, GLsizei count, const GLuint *buffers, const GLintptr *offsets, const GLsizei *strides); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexArrayAttribBinding (GLuint vaobj, GLuint attribindex, GLuint bindingindex); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexArrayAttribFormat (GLuint vaobj, GLuint attribindex, GLint size, GLenum type, GLboolean normalized, GLuint relativeoffset); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexArrayAttribIFormat (GLuint vaobj, GLuint attribindex, GLint size, GLenum type, GLuint relativeoffset); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexArrayAttribLFormat (GLuint vaobj, GLuint attribindex, GLint size, GLenum type, GLuint relativeoffset); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexArrayBindingDivisor (GLuint vaobj, GLuint bindingindex, GLuint divisor); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetVertexArrayiv (GLuint vaobj, GLenum pname, GLint *param); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetVertexArrayIndexediv (GLuint vaobj, GLuint index, GLenum pname, GLint *param); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetVertexArrayIndexed64iv (GLuint vaobj, GLuint index, GLenum pname, GLint64 *param); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glCreateSamplers (GLsizei n, GLuint *samplers); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glCreateProgramPipelines (GLsizei n, GLuint *pipelines); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glCreateQueries (GLenum target, GLsizei n, GLuint *ids); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetQueryBufferObjecti64v (GLuint id, GLuint buffer, GLenum pname, GLintptr offset); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetQueryBufferObjectiv (GLuint id, GLuint buffer, GLenum pname, GLintptr offset); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetQueryBufferObjectui64v (GLuint id, GLuint buffer, GLenum pname, GLintptr offset); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetQueryBufferObjectuiv (GLuint id, GLuint buffer, GLenum pname, GLintptr offset); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glMemoryBarrierByRegion (GLbitfield barriers); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetTextureSubImage (GLuint texture, GLint level, GLint xoffset, GLint yoffset, GLint zoffset, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLsizei depth, GLenum format, GLenum type, GLsizei bufSize, void *pixels); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetCompressedTextureSubImage (GLuint texture, GLint level, GLint xoffset, GLint yoffset, GLint zoffset, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLsizei depth, GLsizei bufSize, void *pixels); +GLAPI GLenum APIENTRY glGetGraphicsResetStatus (void); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetnCompressedTexImage (GLenum target, GLint lod, GLsizei bufSize, void *pixels); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetnTexImage (GLenum target, GLint level, GLenum format, GLenum type, GLsizei bufSize, void *pixels); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetnUniformdv (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei bufSize, GLdouble *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetnUniformfv (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei bufSize, GLfloat *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetnUniformiv (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei bufSize, GLint *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetnUniformuiv (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei bufSize, GLuint *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glReadnPixels (GLint x, GLint y, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLenum format, GLenum type, GLsizei bufSize, void *data); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glTextureBarrier (void); +#endif +#endif /* GL_VERSION_4_5 */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_ES2_compatibility +#define GL_ARB_ES2_compatibility 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_ES2_compatibility */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_ES3_1_compatibility +#define GL_ARB_ES3_1_compatibility 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_ES3_1_compatibility */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_ES3_compatibility +#define GL_ARB_ES3_compatibility 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_ES3_compatibility */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_arrays_of_arrays +#define GL_ARB_arrays_of_arrays 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_arrays_of_arrays */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_base_instance +#define GL_ARB_base_instance 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_base_instance */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_bindless_texture +#define GL_ARB_bindless_texture 1 +typedef uint64_t GLuint64EXT; +#define GL_UNSIGNED_INT64_ARB 0x140F +typedef GLuint64 (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETTEXTUREHANDLEARBPROC) (GLuint texture); +typedef GLuint64 (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETTEXTURESAMPLERHANDLEARBPROC) (GLuint texture, GLuint sampler); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLMAKETEXTUREHANDLERESIDENTARBPROC) (GLuint64 handle); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLMAKETEXTUREHANDLENONRESIDENTARBPROC) (GLuint64 handle); +typedef GLuint64 (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETIMAGEHANDLEARBPROC) (GLuint texture, GLint level, GLboolean layered, GLint layer, GLenum format); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLMAKEIMAGEHANDLERESIDENTARBPROC) (GLuint64 handle, GLenum access); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLMAKEIMAGEHANDLENONRESIDENTARBPROC) (GLuint64 handle); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLUNIFORMHANDLEUI64ARBPROC) (GLint location, GLuint64 value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLUNIFORMHANDLEUI64VARBPROC) (GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLuint64 *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMHANDLEUI64ARBPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLuint64 value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMHANDLEUI64VARBPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLuint64 *values); +typedef GLboolean (APIENTRYP PFNGLISTEXTUREHANDLERESIDENTARBPROC) (GLuint64 handle); +typedef GLboolean (APIENTRYP PFNGLISIMAGEHANDLERESIDENTARBPROC) (GLuint64 handle); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBL1UI64ARBPROC) (GLuint index, GLuint64EXT x); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBL1UI64VARBPROC) (GLuint index, const GLuint64EXT *v); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETVERTEXATTRIBLUI64VARBPROC) (GLuint index, GLenum pname, GLuint64EXT *params); +#ifdef GL_GLEXT_PROTOTYPES +GLAPI GLuint64 APIENTRY glGetTextureHandleARB (GLuint texture); +GLAPI GLuint64 APIENTRY glGetTextureSamplerHandleARB (GLuint texture, GLuint sampler); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glMakeTextureHandleResidentARB (GLuint64 handle); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glMakeTextureHandleNonResidentARB (GLuint64 handle); +GLAPI GLuint64 APIENTRY glGetImageHandleARB (GLuint texture, GLint level, GLboolean layered, GLint layer, GLenum format); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glMakeImageHandleResidentARB (GLuint64 handle, GLenum access); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glMakeImageHandleNonResidentARB (GLuint64 handle); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glUniformHandleui64ARB (GLint location, GLuint64 value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glUniformHandleui64vARB (GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLuint64 *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glProgramUniformHandleui64ARB (GLuint program, GLint location, GLuint64 value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glProgramUniformHandleui64vARB (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei count, const GLuint64 *values); +GLAPI GLboolean APIENTRY glIsTextureHandleResidentARB (GLuint64 handle); +GLAPI GLboolean APIENTRY glIsImageHandleResidentARB (GLuint64 handle); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttribL1ui64ARB (GLuint index, GLuint64EXT x); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttribL1ui64vARB (GLuint index, const GLuint64EXT *v); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetVertexAttribLui64vARB (GLuint index, GLenum pname, GLuint64EXT *params); +#endif +#endif /* GL_ARB_bindless_texture */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_blend_func_extended +#define GL_ARB_blend_func_extended 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_blend_func_extended */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_buffer_storage +#define GL_ARB_buffer_storage 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_buffer_storage */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_cl_event +#define GL_ARB_cl_event 1 +struct _cl_context; +struct _cl_event; +#define GL_SYNC_CL_EVENT_ARB 0x8240 +#define GL_SYNC_CL_EVENT_COMPLETE_ARB 0x8241 +typedef GLsync (APIENTRYP PFNGLCREATESYNCFROMCLEVENTARBPROC) (struct _cl_context *context, struct _cl_event *event, GLbitfield flags); +#ifdef GL_GLEXT_PROTOTYPES +GLAPI GLsync APIENTRY glCreateSyncFromCLeventARB (struct _cl_context *context, struct _cl_event *event, GLbitfield flags); +#endif +#endif /* GL_ARB_cl_event */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_clear_buffer_object +#define GL_ARB_clear_buffer_object 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_clear_buffer_object */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_clear_texture +#define GL_ARB_clear_texture 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_clear_texture */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_clip_control +#define GL_ARB_clip_control 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_clip_control */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_compressed_texture_pixel_storage +#define GL_ARB_compressed_texture_pixel_storage 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_compressed_texture_pixel_storage */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_compute_shader +#define GL_ARB_compute_shader 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_compute_shader */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_compute_variable_group_size +#define GL_ARB_compute_variable_group_size 1 +#define GL_MAX_COMPUTE_VARIABLE_GROUP_INVOCATIONS_ARB 0x9344 +#define GL_MAX_COMPUTE_FIXED_GROUP_INVOCATIONS_ARB 0x90EB +#define GL_MAX_COMPUTE_VARIABLE_GROUP_SIZE_ARB 0x9345 +#define GL_MAX_COMPUTE_FIXED_GROUP_SIZE_ARB 0x91BF +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDISPATCHCOMPUTEGROUPSIZEARBPROC) (GLuint num_groups_x, GLuint num_groups_y, GLuint num_groups_z, GLuint group_size_x, GLuint group_size_y, GLuint group_size_z); +#ifdef GL_GLEXT_PROTOTYPES +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDispatchComputeGroupSizeARB (GLuint num_groups_x, GLuint num_groups_y, GLuint num_groups_z, GLuint group_size_x, GLuint group_size_y, GLuint group_size_z); +#endif +#endif /* GL_ARB_compute_variable_group_size */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_conditional_render_inverted +#define GL_ARB_conditional_render_inverted 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_conditional_render_inverted */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_conservative_depth +#define GL_ARB_conservative_depth 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_conservative_depth */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_copy_buffer +#define GL_ARB_copy_buffer 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_copy_buffer */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_copy_image +#define GL_ARB_copy_image 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_copy_image */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_cull_distance +#define GL_ARB_cull_distance 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_cull_distance */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_debug_output +#define GL_ARB_debug_output 1 +typedef void (APIENTRY *GLDEBUGPROCARB)(GLenum source,GLenum type,GLuint id,GLenum severity,GLsizei length,const GLchar *message,const void *userParam); +#define GL_DEBUG_OUTPUT_SYNCHRONOUS_ARB 0x8242 +#define GL_DEBUG_NEXT_LOGGED_MESSAGE_LENGTH_ARB 0x8243 +#define GL_DEBUG_CALLBACK_FUNCTION_ARB 0x8244 +#define GL_DEBUG_CALLBACK_USER_PARAM_ARB 0x8245 +#define GL_DEBUG_SOURCE_API_ARB 0x8246 +#define GL_DEBUG_SOURCE_WINDOW_SYSTEM_ARB 0x8247 +#define GL_DEBUG_SOURCE_SHADER_COMPILER_ARB 0x8248 +#define GL_DEBUG_SOURCE_THIRD_PARTY_ARB 0x8249 +#define GL_DEBUG_SOURCE_APPLICATION_ARB 0x824A +#define GL_DEBUG_SOURCE_OTHER_ARB 0x824B +#define GL_DEBUG_TYPE_ERROR_ARB 0x824C +#define GL_DEBUG_TYPE_DEPRECATED_BEHAVIOR_ARB 0x824D +#define GL_DEBUG_TYPE_UNDEFINED_BEHAVIOR_ARB 0x824E +#define GL_DEBUG_TYPE_PORTABILITY_ARB 0x824F +#define GL_DEBUG_TYPE_PERFORMANCE_ARB 0x8250 +#define GL_DEBUG_TYPE_OTHER_ARB 0x8251 +#define GL_MAX_DEBUG_MESSAGE_LENGTH_ARB 0x9143 +#define GL_MAX_DEBUG_LOGGED_MESSAGES_ARB 0x9144 +#define GL_DEBUG_LOGGED_MESSAGES_ARB 0x9145 +#define GL_DEBUG_SEVERITY_HIGH_ARB 0x9146 +#define GL_DEBUG_SEVERITY_MEDIUM_ARB 0x9147 +#define GL_DEBUG_SEVERITY_LOW_ARB 0x9148 +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDEBUGMESSAGECONTROLARBPROC) (GLenum source, GLenum type, GLenum severity, GLsizei count, const GLuint *ids, GLboolean enabled); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDEBUGMESSAGEINSERTARBPROC) (GLenum source, GLenum type, GLuint id, GLenum severity, GLsizei length, const GLchar *buf); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDEBUGMESSAGECALLBACKARBPROC) (GLDEBUGPROCARB callback, const void *userParam); +typedef GLuint (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETDEBUGMESSAGELOGARBPROC) (GLuint count, GLsizei bufSize, GLenum *sources, GLenum *types, GLuint *ids, GLenum *severities, GLsizei *lengths, GLchar *messageLog); +#ifdef GL_GLEXT_PROTOTYPES +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDebugMessageControlARB (GLenum source, GLenum type, GLenum severity, GLsizei count, const GLuint *ids, GLboolean enabled); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDebugMessageInsertARB (GLenum source, GLenum type, GLuint id, GLenum severity, GLsizei length, const GLchar *buf); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDebugMessageCallbackARB (GLDEBUGPROCARB callback, const void *userParam); +GLAPI GLuint APIENTRY glGetDebugMessageLogARB (GLuint count, GLsizei bufSize, GLenum *sources, GLenum *types, GLuint *ids, GLenum *severities, GLsizei *lengths, GLchar *messageLog); +#endif +#endif /* GL_ARB_debug_output */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_depth_buffer_float +#define GL_ARB_depth_buffer_float 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_depth_buffer_float */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_depth_clamp +#define GL_ARB_depth_clamp 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_depth_clamp */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_derivative_control +#define GL_ARB_derivative_control 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_derivative_control */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_direct_state_access +#define GL_ARB_direct_state_access 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_direct_state_access */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_draw_buffers_blend +#define GL_ARB_draw_buffers_blend 1 +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLBLENDEQUATIONIARBPROC) (GLuint buf, GLenum mode); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLBLENDEQUATIONSEPARATEIARBPROC) (GLuint buf, GLenum modeRGB, GLenum modeAlpha); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLBLENDFUNCIARBPROC) (GLuint buf, GLenum src, GLenum dst); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLBLENDFUNCSEPARATEIARBPROC) (GLuint buf, GLenum srcRGB, GLenum dstRGB, GLenum srcAlpha, GLenum dstAlpha); +#ifdef GL_GLEXT_PROTOTYPES +GLAPI void APIENTRY glBlendEquationiARB (GLuint buf, GLenum mode); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glBlendEquationSeparateiARB (GLuint buf, GLenum modeRGB, GLenum modeAlpha); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glBlendFunciARB (GLuint buf, GLenum src, GLenum dst); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glBlendFuncSeparateiARB (GLuint buf, GLenum srcRGB, GLenum dstRGB, GLenum srcAlpha, GLenum dstAlpha); +#endif +#endif /* GL_ARB_draw_buffers_blend */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_draw_elements_base_vertex +#define GL_ARB_draw_elements_base_vertex 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_draw_elements_base_vertex */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_draw_indirect +#define GL_ARB_draw_indirect 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_draw_indirect */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_enhanced_layouts +#define GL_ARB_enhanced_layouts 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_enhanced_layouts */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_explicit_attrib_location +#define GL_ARB_explicit_attrib_location 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_explicit_attrib_location */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_explicit_uniform_location +#define GL_ARB_explicit_uniform_location 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_explicit_uniform_location */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_fragment_coord_conventions +#define GL_ARB_fragment_coord_conventions 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_fragment_coord_conventions */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_fragment_layer_viewport +#define GL_ARB_fragment_layer_viewport 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_fragment_layer_viewport */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_framebuffer_no_attachments +#define GL_ARB_framebuffer_no_attachments 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_framebuffer_no_attachments */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_framebuffer_object +#define GL_ARB_framebuffer_object 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_framebuffer_object */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_framebuffer_sRGB +#define GL_ARB_framebuffer_sRGB 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_framebuffer_sRGB */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_get_program_binary +#define GL_ARB_get_program_binary 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_get_program_binary */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_get_texture_sub_image +#define GL_ARB_get_texture_sub_image 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_get_texture_sub_image */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_gpu_shader5 +#define GL_ARB_gpu_shader5 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_gpu_shader5 */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_gpu_shader_fp64 +#define GL_ARB_gpu_shader_fp64 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_gpu_shader_fp64 */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_half_float_vertex +#define GL_ARB_half_float_vertex 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_half_float_vertex */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_imaging +#define GL_ARB_imaging 1 +#define GL_BLEND_COLOR 0x8005 +#define GL_BLEND_EQUATION 0x8009 +#endif /* GL_ARB_imaging */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_indirect_parameters +#define GL_ARB_indirect_parameters 1 +#define GL_PARAMETER_BUFFER_ARB 0x80EE +#define GL_PARAMETER_BUFFER_BINDING_ARB 0x80EF +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLMULTIDRAWARRAYSINDIRECTCOUNTARBPROC) (GLenum mode, GLintptr indirect, GLintptr drawcount, GLsizei maxdrawcount, GLsizei stride); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLMULTIDRAWELEMENTSINDIRECTCOUNTARBPROC) (GLenum mode, GLenum type, GLintptr indirect, GLintptr drawcount, GLsizei maxdrawcount, GLsizei stride); +#ifdef GL_GLEXT_PROTOTYPES +GLAPI void APIENTRY glMultiDrawArraysIndirectCountARB (GLenum mode, GLintptr indirect, GLintptr drawcount, GLsizei maxdrawcount, GLsizei stride); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glMultiDrawElementsIndirectCountARB (GLenum mode, GLenum type, GLintptr indirect, GLintptr drawcount, GLsizei maxdrawcount, GLsizei stride); +#endif +#endif /* GL_ARB_indirect_parameters */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_internalformat_query +#define GL_ARB_internalformat_query 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_internalformat_query */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_internalformat_query2 +#define GL_ARB_internalformat_query2 1 +#define GL_SRGB_DECODE_ARB 0x8299 +#endif /* GL_ARB_internalformat_query2 */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_invalidate_subdata +#define GL_ARB_invalidate_subdata 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_invalidate_subdata */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_map_buffer_alignment +#define GL_ARB_map_buffer_alignment 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_map_buffer_alignment */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_map_buffer_range +#define GL_ARB_map_buffer_range 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_map_buffer_range */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_multi_bind +#define GL_ARB_multi_bind 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_multi_bind */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_multi_draw_indirect +#define GL_ARB_multi_draw_indirect 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_multi_draw_indirect */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_occlusion_query2 +#define GL_ARB_occlusion_query2 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_occlusion_query2 */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_pipeline_statistics_query +#define GL_ARB_pipeline_statistics_query 1 +#define GL_VERTICES_SUBMITTED_ARB 0x82EE +#define GL_PRIMITIVES_SUBMITTED_ARB 0x82EF +#define GL_VERTEX_SHADER_INVOCATIONS_ARB 0x82F0 +#define GL_TESS_CONTROL_SHADER_PATCHES_ARB 0x82F1 +#define GL_TESS_EVALUATION_SHADER_INVOCATIONS_ARB 0x82F2 +#define GL_GEOMETRY_SHADER_PRIMITIVES_EMITTED_ARB 0x82F3 +#define GL_FRAGMENT_SHADER_INVOCATIONS_ARB 0x82F4 +#define GL_COMPUTE_SHADER_INVOCATIONS_ARB 0x82F5 +#define GL_CLIPPING_INPUT_PRIMITIVES_ARB 0x82F6 +#define GL_CLIPPING_OUTPUT_PRIMITIVES_ARB 0x82F7 +#endif /* GL_ARB_pipeline_statistics_query */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_program_interface_query +#define GL_ARB_program_interface_query 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_program_interface_query */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_provoking_vertex +#define GL_ARB_provoking_vertex 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_provoking_vertex */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_query_buffer_object +#define GL_ARB_query_buffer_object 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_query_buffer_object */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_robust_buffer_access_behavior +#define GL_ARB_robust_buffer_access_behavior 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_robust_buffer_access_behavior */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_robustness +#define GL_ARB_robustness 1 +#define GL_CONTEXT_FLAG_ROBUST_ACCESS_BIT_ARB 0x00000004 +#define GL_LOSE_CONTEXT_ON_RESET_ARB 0x8252 +#define GL_GUILTY_CONTEXT_RESET_ARB 0x8253 +#define GL_INNOCENT_CONTEXT_RESET_ARB 0x8254 +#define GL_UNKNOWN_CONTEXT_RESET_ARB 0x8255 +#define GL_RESET_NOTIFICATION_STRATEGY_ARB 0x8256 +#define GL_NO_RESET_NOTIFICATION_ARB 0x8261 +typedef GLenum (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETGRAPHICSRESETSTATUSARBPROC) (void); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETNTEXIMAGEARBPROC) (GLenum target, GLint level, GLenum format, GLenum type, GLsizei bufSize, void *img); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLREADNPIXELSARBPROC) (GLint x, GLint y, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLenum format, GLenum type, GLsizei bufSize, void *data); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETNCOMPRESSEDTEXIMAGEARBPROC) (GLenum target, GLint lod, GLsizei bufSize, void *img); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETNUNIFORMFVARBPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei bufSize, GLfloat *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETNUNIFORMIVARBPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei bufSize, GLint *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETNUNIFORMUIVARBPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei bufSize, GLuint *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETNUNIFORMDVARBPROC) (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei bufSize, GLdouble *params); +#ifdef GL_GLEXT_PROTOTYPES +GLAPI GLenum APIENTRY glGetGraphicsResetStatusARB (void); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetnTexImageARB (GLenum target, GLint level, GLenum format, GLenum type, GLsizei bufSize, void *img); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glReadnPixelsARB (GLint x, GLint y, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLenum format, GLenum type, GLsizei bufSize, void *data); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetnCompressedTexImageARB (GLenum target, GLint lod, GLsizei bufSize, void *img); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetnUniformfvARB (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei bufSize, GLfloat *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetnUniformivARB (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei bufSize, GLint *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetnUniformuivARB (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei bufSize, GLuint *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetnUniformdvARB (GLuint program, GLint location, GLsizei bufSize, GLdouble *params); +#endif +#endif /* GL_ARB_robustness */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_robustness_isolation +#define GL_ARB_robustness_isolation 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_robustness_isolation */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_sample_shading +#define GL_ARB_sample_shading 1 +#define GL_SAMPLE_SHADING_ARB 0x8C36 +#define GL_MIN_SAMPLE_SHADING_VALUE_ARB 0x8C37 +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLMINSAMPLESHADINGARBPROC) (GLfloat value); +#ifdef GL_GLEXT_PROTOTYPES +GLAPI void APIENTRY glMinSampleShadingARB (GLfloat value); +#endif +#endif /* GL_ARB_sample_shading */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_sampler_objects +#define GL_ARB_sampler_objects 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_sampler_objects */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_seamless_cube_map +#define GL_ARB_seamless_cube_map 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_seamless_cube_map */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_seamless_cubemap_per_texture +#define GL_ARB_seamless_cubemap_per_texture 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_seamless_cubemap_per_texture */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_separate_shader_objects +#define GL_ARB_separate_shader_objects 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_separate_shader_objects */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_shader_atomic_counters +#define GL_ARB_shader_atomic_counters 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_shader_atomic_counters */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_shader_bit_encoding +#define GL_ARB_shader_bit_encoding 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_shader_bit_encoding */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_shader_draw_parameters +#define GL_ARB_shader_draw_parameters 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_shader_draw_parameters */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_shader_group_vote +#define GL_ARB_shader_group_vote 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_shader_group_vote */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_shader_image_load_store +#define GL_ARB_shader_image_load_store 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_shader_image_load_store */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_shader_image_size +#define GL_ARB_shader_image_size 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_shader_image_size */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_shader_precision +#define GL_ARB_shader_precision 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_shader_precision */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_shader_stencil_export +#define GL_ARB_shader_stencil_export 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_shader_stencil_export */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_shader_storage_buffer_object +#define GL_ARB_shader_storage_buffer_object 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_shader_storage_buffer_object */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_shader_subroutine +#define GL_ARB_shader_subroutine 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_shader_subroutine */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_shader_texture_image_samples +#define GL_ARB_shader_texture_image_samples 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_shader_texture_image_samples */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_shading_language_420pack +#define GL_ARB_shading_language_420pack 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_shading_language_420pack */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_shading_language_include +#define GL_ARB_shading_language_include 1 +#define GL_SHADER_INCLUDE_ARB 0x8DAE +#define GL_NAMED_STRING_LENGTH_ARB 0x8DE9 +#define GL_NAMED_STRING_TYPE_ARB 0x8DEA +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLNAMEDSTRINGARBPROC) (GLenum type, GLint namelen, const GLchar *name, GLint stringlen, const GLchar *string); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDELETENAMEDSTRINGARBPROC) (GLint namelen, const GLchar *name); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLCOMPILESHADERINCLUDEARBPROC) (GLuint shader, GLsizei count, const GLchar *const*path, const GLint *length); +typedef GLboolean (APIENTRYP PFNGLISNAMEDSTRINGARBPROC) (GLint namelen, const GLchar *name); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETNAMEDSTRINGARBPROC) (GLint namelen, const GLchar *name, GLsizei bufSize, GLint *stringlen, GLchar *string); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETNAMEDSTRINGIVARBPROC) (GLint namelen, const GLchar *name, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +#ifdef GL_GLEXT_PROTOTYPES +GLAPI void APIENTRY glNamedStringARB (GLenum type, GLint namelen, const GLchar *name, GLint stringlen, const GLchar *string); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDeleteNamedStringARB (GLint namelen, const GLchar *name); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glCompileShaderIncludeARB (GLuint shader, GLsizei count, const GLchar *const*path, const GLint *length); +GLAPI GLboolean APIENTRY glIsNamedStringARB (GLint namelen, const GLchar *name); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetNamedStringARB (GLint namelen, const GLchar *name, GLsizei bufSize, GLint *stringlen, GLchar *string); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetNamedStringivARB (GLint namelen, const GLchar *name, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +#endif +#endif /* GL_ARB_shading_language_include */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_shading_language_packing +#define GL_ARB_shading_language_packing 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_shading_language_packing */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_sparse_buffer +#define GL_ARB_sparse_buffer 1 +#define GL_SPARSE_STORAGE_BIT_ARB 0x0400 +#define GL_SPARSE_BUFFER_PAGE_SIZE_ARB 0x82F8 +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLBUFFERPAGECOMMITMENTARBPROC) (GLenum target, GLintptr offset, GLsizeiptr size, GLboolean commit); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLNAMEDBUFFERPAGECOMMITMENTEXTPROC) (GLuint buffer, GLintptr offset, GLsizeiptr size, GLboolean commit); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLNAMEDBUFFERPAGECOMMITMENTARBPROC) (GLuint buffer, GLintptr offset, GLsizeiptr size, GLboolean commit); +#ifdef GL_GLEXT_PROTOTYPES +GLAPI void APIENTRY glBufferPageCommitmentARB (GLenum target, GLintptr offset, GLsizeiptr size, GLboolean commit); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glNamedBufferPageCommitmentEXT (GLuint buffer, GLintptr offset, GLsizeiptr size, GLboolean commit); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glNamedBufferPageCommitmentARB (GLuint buffer, GLintptr offset, GLsizeiptr size, GLboolean commit); +#endif +#endif /* GL_ARB_sparse_buffer */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_sparse_texture +#define GL_ARB_sparse_texture 1 +#define GL_TEXTURE_SPARSE_ARB 0x91A6 +#define GL_VIRTUAL_PAGE_SIZE_INDEX_ARB 0x91A7 +#define GL_NUM_SPARSE_LEVELS_ARB 0x91AA +#define GL_NUM_VIRTUAL_PAGE_SIZES_ARB 0x91A8 +#define GL_VIRTUAL_PAGE_SIZE_X_ARB 0x9195 +#define GL_VIRTUAL_PAGE_SIZE_Y_ARB 0x9196 +#define GL_VIRTUAL_PAGE_SIZE_Z_ARB 0x9197 +#define GL_MAX_SPARSE_TEXTURE_SIZE_ARB 0x9198 +#define GL_MAX_SPARSE_3D_TEXTURE_SIZE_ARB 0x9199 +#define GL_MAX_SPARSE_ARRAY_TEXTURE_LAYERS_ARB 0x919A +#define GL_SPARSE_TEXTURE_FULL_ARRAY_CUBE_MIPMAPS_ARB 0x91A9 +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLTEXPAGECOMMITMENTARBPROC) (GLenum target, GLint level, GLint xoffset, GLint yoffset, GLint zoffset, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLsizei depth, GLboolean commit); +#ifdef GL_GLEXT_PROTOTYPES +GLAPI void APIENTRY glTexPageCommitmentARB (GLenum target, GLint level, GLint xoffset, GLint yoffset, GLint zoffset, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLsizei depth, GLboolean commit); +#endif +#endif /* GL_ARB_sparse_texture */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_stencil_texturing +#define GL_ARB_stencil_texturing 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_stencil_texturing */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_sync +#define GL_ARB_sync 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_sync */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_tessellation_shader +#define GL_ARB_tessellation_shader 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_tessellation_shader */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_texture_barrier +#define GL_ARB_texture_barrier 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_texture_barrier */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_texture_buffer_object_rgb32 +#define GL_ARB_texture_buffer_object_rgb32 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_texture_buffer_object_rgb32 */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_texture_buffer_range +#define GL_ARB_texture_buffer_range 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_texture_buffer_range */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_texture_compression_bptc +#define GL_ARB_texture_compression_bptc 1 +#define GL_COMPRESSED_RGBA_BPTC_UNORM_ARB 0x8E8C +#define GL_COMPRESSED_SRGB_ALPHA_BPTC_UNORM_ARB 0x8E8D +#define GL_COMPRESSED_RGB_BPTC_SIGNED_FLOAT_ARB 0x8E8E +#define GL_COMPRESSED_RGB_BPTC_UNSIGNED_FLOAT_ARB 0x8E8F +#endif /* GL_ARB_texture_compression_bptc */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_texture_compression_rgtc +#define GL_ARB_texture_compression_rgtc 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_texture_compression_rgtc */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_texture_cube_map_array +#define GL_ARB_texture_cube_map_array 1 +#define GL_TEXTURE_CUBE_MAP_ARRAY_ARB 0x9009 +#define GL_TEXTURE_BINDING_CUBE_MAP_ARRAY_ARB 0x900A +#define GL_PROXY_TEXTURE_CUBE_MAP_ARRAY_ARB 0x900B +#define GL_SAMPLER_CUBE_MAP_ARRAY_ARB 0x900C +#define GL_SAMPLER_CUBE_MAP_ARRAY_SHADOW_ARB 0x900D +#define GL_INT_SAMPLER_CUBE_MAP_ARRAY_ARB 0x900E +#define GL_UNSIGNED_INT_SAMPLER_CUBE_MAP_ARRAY_ARB 0x900F +#endif /* GL_ARB_texture_cube_map_array */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_texture_gather +#define GL_ARB_texture_gather 1 +#define GL_MIN_PROGRAM_TEXTURE_GATHER_OFFSET_ARB 0x8E5E +#define GL_MAX_PROGRAM_TEXTURE_GATHER_OFFSET_ARB 0x8E5F +#define GL_MAX_PROGRAM_TEXTURE_GATHER_COMPONENTS_ARB 0x8F9F +#endif /* GL_ARB_texture_gather */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_texture_mirror_clamp_to_edge +#define GL_ARB_texture_mirror_clamp_to_edge 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_texture_mirror_clamp_to_edge */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_texture_multisample +#define GL_ARB_texture_multisample 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_texture_multisample */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_texture_query_levels +#define GL_ARB_texture_query_levels 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_texture_query_levels */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_texture_query_lod +#define GL_ARB_texture_query_lod 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_texture_query_lod */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_texture_rg +#define GL_ARB_texture_rg 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_texture_rg */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_texture_rgb10_a2ui +#define GL_ARB_texture_rgb10_a2ui 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_texture_rgb10_a2ui */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_texture_stencil8 +#define GL_ARB_texture_stencil8 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_texture_stencil8 */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_texture_storage +#define GL_ARB_texture_storage 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_texture_storage */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_texture_storage_multisample +#define GL_ARB_texture_storage_multisample 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_texture_storage_multisample */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_texture_swizzle +#define GL_ARB_texture_swizzle 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_texture_swizzle */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_texture_view +#define GL_ARB_texture_view 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_texture_view */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_timer_query +#define GL_ARB_timer_query 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_timer_query */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_transform_feedback2 +#define GL_ARB_transform_feedback2 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_transform_feedback2 */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_transform_feedback3 +#define GL_ARB_transform_feedback3 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_transform_feedback3 */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_transform_feedback_instanced +#define GL_ARB_transform_feedback_instanced 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_transform_feedback_instanced */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_transform_feedback_overflow_query +#define GL_ARB_transform_feedback_overflow_query 1 +#define GL_TRANSFORM_FEEDBACK_OVERFLOW_ARB 0x82EC +#define GL_TRANSFORM_FEEDBACK_STREAM_OVERFLOW_ARB 0x82ED +#endif /* GL_ARB_transform_feedback_overflow_query */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_uniform_buffer_object +#define GL_ARB_uniform_buffer_object 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_uniform_buffer_object */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_vertex_array_bgra +#define GL_ARB_vertex_array_bgra 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_vertex_array_bgra */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_vertex_array_object +#define GL_ARB_vertex_array_object 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_vertex_array_object */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_vertex_attrib_64bit +#define GL_ARB_vertex_attrib_64bit 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_vertex_attrib_64bit */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_vertex_attrib_binding +#define GL_ARB_vertex_attrib_binding 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_vertex_attrib_binding */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_vertex_type_10f_11f_11f_rev +#define GL_ARB_vertex_type_10f_11f_11f_rev 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_vertex_type_10f_11f_11f_rev */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_vertex_type_2_10_10_10_rev +#define GL_ARB_vertex_type_2_10_10_10_rev 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_vertex_type_2_10_10_10_rev */ + +#ifndef GL_ARB_viewport_array +#define GL_ARB_viewport_array 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_viewport_array */ + +#ifndef GL_KHR_context_flush_control +#define GL_KHR_context_flush_control 1 +#endif /* GL_KHR_context_flush_control */ + +#ifndef GL_KHR_debug +#define GL_KHR_debug 1 +#endif /* GL_KHR_debug */ + +#ifndef GL_KHR_no_error +#define GL_KHR_no_error 1 +#define GL_CONTEXT_FLAG_NO_ERROR_BIT_KHR 0x00000008 +#endif /* GL_KHR_no_error */ + +#ifndef GL_KHR_robust_buffer_access_behavior +#define GL_KHR_robust_buffer_access_behavior 1 +#endif /* GL_KHR_robust_buffer_access_behavior */ + +#ifndef GL_KHR_robustness +#define GL_KHR_robustness 1 +#define GL_CONTEXT_ROBUST_ACCESS 0x90F3 +#endif /* GL_KHR_robustness */ + +#ifndef GL_KHR_texture_compression_astc_hdr +#define GL_KHR_texture_compression_astc_hdr 1 +#define GL_COMPRESSED_RGBA_ASTC_4x4_KHR 0x93B0 +#define GL_COMPRESSED_RGBA_ASTC_5x4_KHR 0x93B1 +#define GL_COMPRESSED_RGBA_ASTC_5x5_KHR 0x93B2 +#define GL_COMPRESSED_RGBA_ASTC_6x5_KHR 0x93B3 +#define GL_COMPRESSED_RGBA_ASTC_6x6_KHR 0x93B4 +#define GL_COMPRESSED_RGBA_ASTC_8x5_KHR 0x93B5 +#define GL_COMPRESSED_RGBA_ASTC_8x6_KHR 0x93B6 +#define GL_COMPRESSED_RGBA_ASTC_8x8_KHR 0x93B7 +#define GL_COMPRESSED_RGBA_ASTC_10x5_KHR 0x93B8 +#define GL_COMPRESSED_RGBA_ASTC_10x6_KHR 0x93B9 +#define GL_COMPRESSED_RGBA_ASTC_10x8_KHR 0x93BA +#define GL_COMPRESSED_RGBA_ASTC_10x10_KHR 0x93BB +#define GL_COMPRESSED_RGBA_ASTC_12x10_KHR 0x93BC +#define GL_COMPRESSED_RGBA_ASTC_12x12_KHR 0x93BD +#define GL_COMPRESSED_SRGB8_ALPHA8_ASTC_4x4_KHR 0x93D0 +#define GL_COMPRESSED_SRGB8_ALPHA8_ASTC_5x4_KHR 0x93D1 +#define GL_COMPRESSED_SRGB8_ALPHA8_ASTC_5x5_KHR 0x93D2 +#define GL_COMPRESSED_SRGB8_ALPHA8_ASTC_6x5_KHR 0x93D3 +#define GL_COMPRESSED_SRGB8_ALPHA8_ASTC_6x6_KHR 0x93D4 +#define GL_COMPRESSED_SRGB8_ALPHA8_ASTC_8x5_KHR 0x93D5 +#define GL_COMPRESSED_SRGB8_ALPHA8_ASTC_8x6_KHR 0x93D6 +#define GL_COMPRESSED_SRGB8_ALPHA8_ASTC_8x8_KHR 0x93D7 +#define GL_COMPRESSED_SRGB8_ALPHA8_ASTC_10x5_KHR 0x93D8 +#define GL_COMPRESSED_SRGB8_ALPHA8_ASTC_10x6_KHR 0x93D9 +#define GL_COMPRESSED_SRGB8_ALPHA8_ASTC_10x8_KHR 0x93DA +#define GL_COMPRESSED_SRGB8_ALPHA8_ASTC_10x10_KHR 0x93DB +#define GL_COMPRESSED_SRGB8_ALPHA8_ASTC_12x10_KHR 0x93DC +#define GL_COMPRESSED_SRGB8_ALPHA8_ASTC_12x12_KHR 0x93DD +#endif /* GL_KHR_texture_compression_astc_hdr */ + +#ifndef GL_KHR_texture_compression_astc_ldr +#define GL_KHR_texture_compression_astc_ldr 1 +#endif /* GL_KHR_texture_compression_astc_ldr */ + +#ifndef GL_KHR_texture_compression_astc_sliced_3d +#define GL_KHR_texture_compression_astc_sliced_3d 1 +#endif /* GL_KHR_texture_compression_astc_sliced_3d */ + +#ifdef __cplusplus +} +#endif + +#endif diff --git a/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/gl3w/src/gl3w.c b/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/gl3w/src/gl3w.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000..ade4a68 --- /dev/null +++ b/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/gl3w/src/gl3w.c @@ -0,0 +1,1563 @@ +/* + + This file was generated with gl3w_gen.py, part of gl3w + (hosted at https://github.com/skaslev/gl3w) + + This is free and unencumbered software released into the public domain. + + Anyone is free to copy, modify, publish, use, compile, sell, or + distribute this software, either in source code form or as a compiled + binary, for any purpose, commercial or non-commercial, and by any + means. + + In jurisdictions that recognize copyright laws, the author or authors + of this software dedicate any and all copyright interest in the + software to the public domain. We make this dedication for the benefit + of the public at large and to the detriment of our heirs and + successors. We intend this dedication to be an overt act of + relinquishment in perpetuity of all present and future rights to this + software under copyright law. + + THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, + EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF + MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. + IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR + OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, + ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR + OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. + +*/ + +#include + +#ifdef _WIN32 +#define WIN32_LEAN_AND_MEAN 1 +#include + +static HMODULE libgl; + +static void open_libgl(void) +{ + libgl = LoadLibraryA("opengl32.dll"); +} + +static void close_libgl(void) +{ + FreeLibrary(libgl); +} + +static GL3WglProc get_proc(const char *proc) +{ + GL3WglProc res; + + res = (GL3WglProc) wglGetProcAddress(proc); + if (!res) + res = (GL3WglProc) GetProcAddress(libgl, proc); + return res; +} +#elif defined(__APPLE__) || defined(__APPLE_CC__) +#include + +CFBundleRef bundle; +CFURLRef bundleURL; + +static void open_libgl(void) +{ + bundleURL = CFURLCreateWithFileSystemPath(kCFAllocatorDefault, + CFSTR("/System/Library/Frameworks/OpenGL.framework"), + kCFURLPOSIXPathStyle, true); + + bundle = CFBundleCreate(kCFAllocatorDefault, bundleURL); + assert(bundle != NULL); +} + +static void close_libgl(void) +{ + CFRelease(bundle); + CFRelease(bundleURL); +} + +static GL3WglProc get_proc(const char *proc) +{ + GL3WglProc res; + + CFStringRef procname = CFStringCreateWithCString(kCFAllocatorDefault, proc, + kCFStringEncodingASCII); + res = (GL3WglProc) CFBundleGetFunctionPointerForName(bundle, procname); + CFRelease(procname); + return res; +} +#else +#include +#include + +static void *libgl; +static PFNGLXGETPROCADDRESSPROC glx_get_proc_address; + +static void open_libgl(void) +{ + libgl = dlopen("libGL.so.1", RTLD_LAZY | RTLD_GLOBAL); + glx_get_proc_address = (PFNGLXGETPROCADDRESSPROC) dlsym(libgl, "glXGetProcAddressARB"); +} + +static void close_libgl(void) +{ + dlclose(libgl); +} + +static GL3WglProc get_proc(const char *proc) +{ + GL3WglProc res; + + res = (GL3WglProc) glx_get_proc_address((const GLubyte *) proc); + if (!res) + res = (GL3WglProc) dlsym(libgl, proc); + return res; +} +#endif + +static struct { + int major, minor; +} version; + +static int parse_version(void) +{ + if (!glGetIntegerv) + return -1; + + glGetIntegerv(GL_MAJOR_VERSION, &version.major); + glGetIntegerv(GL_MINOR_VERSION, &version.minor); + + if (version.major < 3) + return -1; + return 0; +} + +static void load_procs(void); + +int gl3wInit(void) +{ + open_libgl(); + load_procs(); + close_libgl(); + return parse_version(); +} + +int gl3wIsSupported(int major, int minor) +{ + if (major < 3) + return 0; + if (version.major == major) + return version.minor >= minor; + return version.major >= major; +} + +GL3WglProc gl3wGetProcAddress(const char *proc) +{ + return get_proc(proc); +} + +PFNGLACTIVESHADERPROGRAMPROC gl3wActiveShaderProgram; +PFNGLACTIVETEXTUREPROC gl3wActiveTexture; +PFNGLATTACHSHADERPROC gl3wAttachShader; +PFNGLBEGINCONDITIONALRENDERPROC gl3wBeginConditionalRender; +PFNGLBEGINQUERYPROC gl3wBeginQuery; +PFNGLBEGINQUERYINDEXEDPROC gl3wBeginQueryIndexed; +PFNGLBEGINTRANSFORMFEEDBACKPROC gl3wBeginTransformFeedback; +PFNGLBINDATTRIBLOCATIONPROC gl3wBindAttribLocation; +PFNGLBINDBUFFERPROC gl3wBindBuffer; +PFNGLBINDBUFFERBASEPROC gl3wBindBufferBase; +PFNGLBINDBUFFERRANGEPROC gl3wBindBufferRange; +PFNGLBINDBUFFERSBASEPROC gl3wBindBuffersBase; +PFNGLBINDBUFFERSRANGEPROC gl3wBindBuffersRange; +PFNGLBINDFRAGDATALOCATIONPROC gl3wBindFragDataLocation; +PFNGLBINDFRAGDATALOCATIONINDEXEDPROC gl3wBindFragDataLocationIndexed; +PFNGLBINDFRAMEBUFFERPROC gl3wBindFramebuffer; +PFNGLBINDIMAGETEXTUREPROC gl3wBindImageTexture; +PFNGLBINDIMAGETEXTURESPROC gl3wBindImageTextures; +PFNGLBINDPROGRAMPIPELINEPROC gl3wBindProgramPipeline; +PFNGLBINDRENDERBUFFERPROC gl3wBindRenderbuffer; +PFNGLBINDSAMPLERPROC gl3wBindSampler; +PFNGLBINDSAMPLERSPROC gl3wBindSamplers; +PFNGLBINDTEXTUREPROC gl3wBindTexture; +PFNGLBINDTEXTUREUNITPROC gl3wBindTextureUnit; +PFNGLBINDTEXTURESPROC gl3wBindTextures; +PFNGLBINDTRANSFORMFEEDBACKPROC gl3wBindTransformFeedback; +PFNGLBINDVERTEXARRAYPROC gl3wBindVertexArray; +PFNGLBINDVERTEXBUFFERPROC gl3wBindVertexBuffer; +PFNGLBINDVERTEXBUFFERSPROC gl3wBindVertexBuffers; +PFNGLBLENDCOLORPROC gl3wBlendColor; +PFNGLBLENDEQUATIONPROC gl3wBlendEquation; +PFNGLBLENDEQUATIONSEPARATEPROC gl3wBlendEquationSeparate; +PFNGLBLENDEQUATIONSEPARATEIPROC gl3wBlendEquationSeparatei; +PFNGLBLENDEQUATIONSEPARATEIARBPROC gl3wBlendEquationSeparateiARB; +PFNGLBLENDEQUATIONIPROC gl3wBlendEquationi; +PFNGLBLENDEQUATIONIARBPROC gl3wBlendEquationiARB; +PFNGLBLENDFUNCPROC gl3wBlendFunc; +PFNGLBLENDFUNCSEPARATEPROC gl3wBlendFuncSeparate; +PFNGLBLENDFUNCSEPARATEIPROC gl3wBlendFuncSeparatei; +PFNGLBLENDFUNCSEPARATEIARBPROC gl3wBlendFuncSeparateiARB; +PFNGLBLENDFUNCIPROC gl3wBlendFunci; +PFNGLBLENDFUNCIARBPROC gl3wBlendFunciARB; +PFNGLBLITFRAMEBUFFERPROC gl3wBlitFramebuffer; +PFNGLBLITNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERPROC gl3wBlitNamedFramebuffer; +PFNGLBUFFERDATAPROC gl3wBufferData; +PFNGLBUFFERPAGECOMMITMENTARBPROC gl3wBufferPageCommitmentARB; +PFNGLBUFFERSTORAGEPROC gl3wBufferStorage; +PFNGLBUFFERSUBDATAPROC gl3wBufferSubData; +PFNGLCHECKFRAMEBUFFERSTATUSPROC gl3wCheckFramebufferStatus; +PFNGLCHECKNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERSTATUSPROC gl3wCheckNamedFramebufferStatus; +PFNGLCLAMPCOLORPROC gl3wClampColor; +PFNGLCLEARPROC gl3wClear; +PFNGLCLEARBUFFERDATAPROC gl3wClearBufferData; +PFNGLCLEARBUFFERSUBDATAPROC gl3wClearBufferSubData; +PFNGLCLEARBUFFERFIPROC gl3wClearBufferfi; +PFNGLCLEARBUFFERFVPROC gl3wClearBufferfv; +PFNGLCLEARBUFFERIVPROC gl3wClearBufferiv; +PFNGLCLEARBUFFERUIVPROC gl3wClearBufferuiv; +PFNGLCLEARCOLORPROC gl3wClearColor; +PFNGLCLEARDEPTHPROC gl3wClearDepth; +PFNGLCLEARDEPTHFPROC gl3wClearDepthf; +PFNGLCLEARNAMEDBUFFERDATAPROC gl3wClearNamedBufferData; +PFNGLCLEARNAMEDBUFFERSUBDATAPROC gl3wClearNamedBufferSubData; +PFNGLCLEARNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERFIPROC gl3wClearNamedFramebufferfi; +PFNGLCLEARNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERFVPROC gl3wClearNamedFramebufferfv; +PFNGLCLEARNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERIVPROC gl3wClearNamedFramebufferiv; +PFNGLCLEARNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERUIVPROC gl3wClearNamedFramebufferuiv; +PFNGLCLEARSTENCILPROC gl3wClearStencil; +PFNGLCLEARTEXIMAGEPROC gl3wClearTexImage; +PFNGLCLEARTEXSUBIMAGEPROC gl3wClearTexSubImage; +PFNGLCLIENTWAITSYNCPROC gl3wClientWaitSync; +PFNGLCLIPCONTROLPROC gl3wClipControl; +PFNGLCOLORMASKPROC gl3wColorMask; +PFNGLCOLORMASKIPROC gl3wColorMaski; +PFNGLCOMPILESHADERPROC gl3wCompileShader; +PFNGLCOMPILESHADERINCLUDEARBPROC gl3wCompileShaderIncludeARB; +PFNGLCOMPRESSEDTEXIMAGE1DPROC gl3wCompressedTexImage1D; +PFNGLCOMPRESSEDTEXIMAGE2DPROC gl3wCompressedTexImage2D; +PFNGLCOMPRESSEDTEXIMAGE3DPROC gl3wCompressedTexImage3D; +PFNGLCOMPRESSEDTEXSUBIMAGE1DPROC gl3wCompressedTexSubImage1D; +PFNGLCOMPRESSEDTEXSUBIMAGE2DPROC gl3wCompressedTexSubImage2D; +PFNGLCOMPRESSEDTEXSUBIMAGE3DPROC gl3wCompressedTexSubImage3D; +PFNGLCOMPRESSEDTEXTURESUBIMAGE1DPROC gl3wCompressedTextureSubImage1D; +PFNGLCOMPRESSEDTEXTURESUBIMAGE2DPROC gl3wCompressedTextureSubImage2D; +PFNGLCOMPRESSEDTEXTURESUBIMAGE3DPROC gl3wCompressedTextureSubImage3D; +PFNGLCOPYBUFFERSUBDATAPROC gl3wCopyBufferSubData; +PFNGLCOPYIMAGESUBDATAPROC gl3wCopyImageSubData; +PFNGLCOPYNAMEDBUFFERSUBDATAPROC gl3wCopyNamedBufferSubData; +PFNGLCOPYTEXIMAGE1DPROC gl3wCopyTexImage1D; +PFNGLCOPYTEXIMAGE2DPROC gl3wCopyTexImage2D; +PFNGLCOPYTEXSUBIMAGE1DPROC gl3wCopyTexSubImage1D; +PFNGLCOPYTEXSUBIMAGE2DPROC gl3wCopyTexSubImage2D; +PFNGLCOPYTEXSUBIMAGE3DPROC gl3wCopyTexSubImage3D; +PFNGLCOPYTEXTURESUBIMAGE1DPROC gl3wCopyTextureSubImage1D; +PFNGLCOPYTEXTURESUBIMAGE2DPROC gl3wCopyTextureSubImage2D; +PFNGLCOPYTEXTURESUBIMAGE3DPROC gl3wCopyTextureSubImage3D; +PFNGLCREATEBUFFERSPROC gl3wCreateBuffers; +PFNGLCREATEFRAMEBUFFERSPROC gl3wCreateFramebuffers; +PFNGLCREATEPROGRAMPROC gl3wCreateProgram; +PFNGLCREATEPROGRAMPIPELINESPROC gl3wCreateProgramPipelines; +PFNGLCREATEQUERIESPROC gl3wCreateQueries; +PFNGLCREATERENDERBUFFERSPROC gl3wCreateRenderbuffers; +PFNGLCREATESAMPLERSPROC gl3wCreateSamplers; +PFNGLCREATESHADERPROC gl3wCreateShader; +PFNGLCREATESHADERPROGRAMVPROC gl3wCreateShaderProgramv; +PFNGLCREATESYNCFROMCLEVENTARBPROC gl3wCreateSyncFromCLeventARB; +PFNGLCREATETEXTURESPROC gl3wCreateTextures; +PFNGLCREATETRANSFORMFEEDBACKSPROC gl3wCreateTransformFeedbacks; +PFNGLCREATEVERTEXARRAYSPROC gl3wCreateVertexArrays; +PFNGLCULLFACEPROC gl3wCullFace; +PFNGLDEBUGMESSAGECALLBACKPROC gl3wDebugMessageCallback; +PFNGLDEBUGMESSAGECALLBACKARBPROC gl3wDebugMessageCallbackARB; +PFNGLDEBUGMESSAGECONTROLPROC gl3wDebugMessageControl; +PFNGLDEBUGMESSAGECONTROLARBPROC gl3wDebugMessageControlARB; +PFNGLDEBUGMESSAGEINSERTPROC gl3wDebugMessageInsert; +PFNGLDEBUGMESSAGEINSERTARBPROC gl3wDebugMessageInsertARB; +PFNGLDELETEBUFFERSPROC gl3wDeleteBuffers; +PFNGLDELETEFRAMEBUFFERSPROC gl3wDeleteFramebuffers; +PFNGLDELETENAMEDSTRINGARBPROC gl3wDeleteNamedStringARB; +PFNGLDELETEPROGRAMPROC gl3wDeleteProgram; +PFNGLDELETEPROGRAMPIPELINESPROC gl3wDeleteProgramPipelines; +PFNGLDELETEQUERIESPROC gl3wDeleteQueries; +PFNGLDELETERENDERBUFFERSPROC gl3wDeleteRenderbuffers; +PFNGLDELETESAMPLERSPROC gl3wDeleteSamplers; +PFNGLDELETESHADERPROC gl3wDeleteShader; +PFNGLDELETESYNCPROC gl3wDeleteSync; +PFNGLDELETETEXTURESPROC gl3wDeleteTextures; +PFNGLDELETETRANSFORMFEEDBACKSPROC gl3wDeleteTransformFeedbacks; +PFNGLDELETEVERTEXARRAYSPROC gl3wDeleteVertexArrays; +PFNGLDEPTHFUNCPROC gl3wDepthFunc; +PFNGLDEPTHMASKPROC gl3wDepthMask; +PFNGLDEPTHRANGEPROC gl3wDepthRange; +PFNGLDEPTHRANGEARRAYVPROC gl3wDepthRangeArrayv; +PFNGLDEPTHRANGEINDEXEDPROC gl3wDepthRangeIndexed; +PFNGLDEPTHRANGEFPROC gl3wDepthRangef; +PFNGLDETACHSHADERPROC gl3wDetachShader; +PFNGLDISABLEPROC gl3wDisable; +PFNGLDISABLEVERTEXARRAYATTRIBPROC gl3wDisableVertexArrayAttrib; +PFNGLDISABLEVERTEXATTRIBARRAYPROC gl3wDisableVertexAttribArray; +PFNGLDISABLEIPROC gl3wDisablei; +PFNGLDISPATCHCOMPUTEPROC gl3wDispatchCompute; +PFNGLDISPATCHCOMPUTEGROUPSIZEARBPROC gl3wDispatchComputeGroupSizeARB; +PFNGLDISPATCHCOMPUTEINDIRECTPROC gl3wDispatchComputeIndirect; +PFNGLDRAWARRAYSPROC gl3wDrawArrays; +PFNGLDRAWARRAYSINDIRECTPROC gl3wDrawArraysIndirect; +PFNGLDRAWARRAYSINSTANCEDPROC gl3wDrawArraysInstanced; +PFNGLDRAWARRAYSINSTANCEDBASEINSTANCEPROC gl3wDrawArraysInstancedBaseInstance; +PFNGLDRAWBUFFERPROC gl3wDrawBuffer; +PFNGLDRAWBUFFERSPROC gl3wDrawBuffers; +PFNGLDRAWELEMENTSPROC gl3wDrawElements; +PFNGLDRAWELEMENTSBASEVERTEXPROC gl3wDrawElementsBaseVertex; +PFNGLDRAWELEMENTSINDIRECTPROC gl3wDrawElementsIndirect; +PFNGLDRAWELEMENTSINSTANCEDPROC gl3wDrawElementsInstanced; +PFNGLDRAWELEMENTSINSTANCEDBASEINSTANCEPROC gl3wDrawElementsInstancedBaseInstance; +PFNGLDRAWELEMENTSINSTANCEDBASEVERTEXPROC gl3wDrawElementsInstancedBaseVertex; +PFNGLDRAWELEMENTSINSTANCEDBASEVERTEXBASEINSTANCEPROC gl3wDrawElementsInstancedBaseVertexBaseInstance; +PFNGLDRAWRANGEELEMENTSPROC gl3wDrawRangeElements; +PFNGLDRAWRANGEELEMENTSBASEVERTEXPROC gl3wDrawRangeElementsBaseVertex; +PFNGLDRAWTRANSFORMFEEDBACKPROC gl3wDrawTransformFeedback; +PFNGLDRAWTRANSFORMFEEDBACKINSTANCEDPROC gl3wDrawTransformFeedbackInstanced; +PFNGLDRAWTRANSFORMFEEDBACKSTREAMPROC gl3wDrawTransformFeedbackStream; +PFNGLDRAWTRANSFORMFEEDBACKSTREAMINSTANCEDPROC gl3wDrawTransformFeedbackStreamInstanced; +PFNGLENABLEPROC gl3wEnable; +PFNGLENABLEVERTEXARRAYATTRIBPROC gl3wEnableVertexArrayAttrib; +PFNGLENABLEVERTEXATTRIBARRAYPROC gl3wEnableVertexAttribArray; +PFNGLENABLEIPROC gl3wEnablei; +PFNGLENDCONDITIONALRENDERPROC gl3wEndConditionalRender; +PFNGLENDQUERYPROC gl3wEndQuery; +PFNGLENDQUERYINDEXEDPROC gl3wEndQueryIndexed; +PFNGLENDTRANSFORMFEEDBACKPROC gl3wEndTransformFeedback; +PFNGLFENCESYNCPROC gl3wFenceSync; +PFNGLFINISHPROC gl3wFinish; +PFNGLFLUSHPROC gl3wFlush; +PFNGLFLUSHMAPPEDBUFFERRANGEPROC gl3wFlushMappedBufferRange; +PFNGLFLUSHMAPPEDNAMEDBUFFERRANGEPROC gl3wFlushMappedNamedBufferRange; +PFNGLFRAMEBUFFERPARAMETERIPROC gl3wFramebufferParameteri; +PFNGLFRAMEBUFFERRENDERBUFFERPROC gl3wFramebufferRenderbuffer; +PFNGLFRAMEBUFFERTEXTUREPROC gl3wFramebufferTexture; +PFNGLFRAMEBUFFERTEXTURE1DPROC gl3wFramebufferTexture1D; +PFNGLFRAMEBUFFERTEXTURE2DPROC gl3wFramebufferTexture2D; +PFNGLFRAMEBUFFERTEXTURE3DPROC gl3wFramebufferTexture3D; +PFNGLFRAMEBUFFERTEXTURELAYERPROC gl3wFramebufferTextureLayer; +PFNGLFRONTFACEPROC gl3wFrontFace; +PFNGLGENBUFFERSPROC gl3wGenBuffers; +PFNGLGENFRAMEBUFFERSPROC gl3wGenFramebuffers; +PFNGLGENPROGRAMPIPELINESPROC gl3wGenProgramPipelines; +PFNGLGENQUERIESPROC gl3wGenQueries; +PFNGLGENRENDERBUFFERSPROC gl3wGenRenderbuffers; +PFNGLGENSAMPLERSPROC gl3wGenSamplers; +PFNGLGENTEXTURESPROC gl3wGenTextures; +PFNGLGENTRANSFORMFEEDBACKSPROC gl3wGenTransformFeedbacks; +PFNGLGENVERTEXARRAYSPROC gl3wGenVertexArrays; +PFNGLGENERATEMIPMAPPROC gl3wGenerateMipmap; +PFNGLGENERATETEXTUREMIPMAPPROC gl3wGenerateTextureMipmap; +PFNGLGETACTIVEATOMICCOUNTERBUFFERIVPROC gl3wGetActiveAtomicCounterBufferiv; +PFNGLGETACTIVEATTRIBPROC gl3wGetActiveAttrib; +PFNGLGETACTIVESUBROUTINENAMEPROC gl3wGetActiveSubroutineName; +PFNGLGETACTIVESUBROUTINEUNIFORMNAMEPROC gl3wGetActiveSubroutineUniformName; +PFNGLGETACTIVESUBROUTINEUNIFORMIVPROC gl3wGetActiveSubroutineUniformiv; +PFNGLGETACTIVEUNIFORMPROC gl3wGetActiveUniform; +PFNGLGETACTIVEUNIFORMBLOCKNAMEPROC gl3wGetActiveUniformBlockName; +PFNGLGETACTIVEUNIFORMBLOCKIVPROC gl3wGetActiveUniformBlockiv; +PFNGLGETACTIVEUNIFORMNAMEPROC gl3wGetActiveUniformName; +PFNGLGETACTIVEUNIFORMSIVPROC gl3wGetActiveUniformsiv; +PFNGLGETATTACHEDSHADERSPROC gl3wGetAttachedShaders; +PFNGLGETATTRIBLOCATIONPROC gl3wGetAttribLocation; +PFNGLGETBOOLEANI_VPROC gl3wGetBooleani_v; +PFNGLGETBOOLEANVPROC gl3wGetBooleanv; +PFNGLGETBUFFERPARAMETERI64VPROC gl3wGetBufferParameteri64v; +PFNGLGETBUFFERPARAMETERIVPROC gl3wGetBufferParameteriv; +PFNGLGETBUFFERPOINTERVPROC gl3wGetBufferPointerv; +PFNGLGETBUFFERSUBDATAPROC gl3wGetBufferSubData; +PFNGLGETCOMPRESSEDTEXIMAGEPROC gl3wGetCompressedTexImage; +PFNGLGETCOMPRESSEDTEXTUREIMAGEPROC gl3wGetCompressedTextureImage; +PFNGLGETCOMPRESSEDTEXTURESUBIMAGEPROC gl3wGetCompressedTextureSubImage; +PFNGLGETDEBUGMESSAGELOGPROC gl3wGetDebugMessageLog; +PFNGLGETDEBUGMESSAGELOGARBPROC gl3wGetDebugMessageLogARB; +PFNGLGETDOUBLEI_VPROC gl3wGetDoublei_v; +PFNGLGETDOUBLEVPROC gl3wGetDoublev; +PFNGLGETERRORPROC gl3wGetError; +PFNGLGETFLOATI_VPROC gl3wGetFloati_v; +PFNGLGETFLOATVPROC gl3wGetFloatv; +PFNGLGETFRAGDATAINDEXPROC gl3wGetFragDataIndex; +PFNGLGETFRAGDATALOCATIONPROC gl3wGetFragDataLocation; +PFNGLGETFRAMEBUFFERATTACHMENTPARAMETERIVPROC gl3wGetFramebufferAttachmentParameteriv; +PFNGLGETFRAMEBUFFERPARAMETERIVPROC gl3wGetFramebufferParameteriv; +PFNGLGETGRAPHICSRESETSTATUSPROC gl3wGetGraphicsResetStatus; +PFNGLGETGRAPHICSRESETSTATUSARBPROC gl3wGetGraphicsResetStatusARB; +PFNGLGETIMAGEHANDLEARBPROC gl3wGetImageHandleARB; +PFNGLGETINTEGER64I_VPROC gl3wGetInteger64i_v; +PFNGLGETINTEGER64VPROC gl3wGetInteger64v; +PFNGLGETINTEGERI_VPROC gl3wGetIntegeri_v; +PFNGLGETINTEGERVPROC gl3wGetIntegerv; +PFNGLGETINTERNALFORMATI64VPROC gl3wGetInternalformati64v; +PFNGLGETINTERNALFORMATIVPROC gl3wGetInternalformativ; +PFNGLGETMULTISAMPLEFVPROC gl3wGetMultisamplefv; +PFNGLGETNAMEDBUFFERPARAMETERI64VPROC gl3wGetNamedBufferParameteri64v; +PFNGLGETNAMEDBUFFERPARAMETERIVPROC gl3wGetNamedBufferParameteriv; +PFNGLGETNAMEDBUFFERPOINTERVPROC gl3wGetNamedBufferPointerv; +PFNGLGETNAMEDBUFFERSUBDATAPROC gl3wGetNamedBufferSubData; +PFNGLGETNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERATTACHMENTPARAMETERIVPROC gl3wGetNamedFramebufferAttachmentParameteriv; +PFNGLGETNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERPARAMETERIVPROC gl3wGetNamedFramebufferParameteriv; +PFNGLGETNAMEDRENDERBUFFERPARAMETERIVPROC gl3wGetNamedRenderbufferParameteriv; +PFNGLGETNAMEDSTRINGARBPROC gl3wGetNamedStringARB; +PFNGLGETNAMEDSTRINGIVARBPROC gl3wGetNamedStringivARB; +PFNGLGETOBJECTLABELPROC gl3wGetObjectLabel; +PFNGLGETOBJECTPTRLABELPROC gl3wGetObjectPtrLabel; +PFNGLGETPOINTERVPROC gl3wGetPointerv; +PFNGLGETPROGRAMBINARYPROC gl3wGetProgramBinary; +PFNGLGETPROGRAMINFOLOGPROC gl3wGetProgramInfoLog; +PFNGLGETPROGRAMINTERFACEIVPROC gl3wGetProgramInterfaceiv; +PFNGLGETPROGRAMPIPELINEINFOLOGPROC gl3wGetProgramPipelineInfoLog; +PFNGLGETPROGRAMPIPELINEIVPROC gl3wGetProgramPipelineiv; +PFNGLGETPROGRAMRESOURCEINDEXPROC gl3wGetProgramResourceIndex; +PFNGLGETPROGRAMRESOURCELOCATIONPROC gl3wGetProgramResourceLocation; +PFNGLGETPROGRAMRESOURCELOCATIONINDEXPROC gl3wGetProgramResourceLocationIndex; +PFNGLGETPROGRAMRESOURCENAMEPROC gl3wGetProgramResourceName; +PFNGLGETPROGRAMRESOURCEIVPROC gl3wGetProgramResourceiv; +PFNGLGETPROGRAMSTAGEIVPROC gl3wGetProgramStageiv; +PFNGLGETPROGRAMIVPROC gl3wGetProgramiv; +PFNGLGETQUERYBUFFEROBJECTI64VPROC gl3wGetQueryBufferObjecti64v; +PFNGLGETQUERYBUFFEROBJECTIVPROC gl3wGetQueryBufferObjectiv; +PFNGLGETQUERYBUFFEROBJECTUI64VPROC gl3wGetQueryBufferObjectui64v; +PFNGLGETQUERYBUFFEROBJECTUIVPROC gl3wGetQueryBufferObjectuiv; +PFNGLGETQUERYINDEXEDIVPROC gl3wGetQueryIndexediv; +PFNGLGETQUERYOBJECTI64VPROC gl3wGetQueryObjecti64v; +PFNGLGETQUERYOBJECTIVPROC gl3wGetQueryObjectiv; +PFNGLGETQUERYOBJECTUI64VPROC gl3wGetQueryObjectui64v; +PFNGLGETQUERYOBJECTUIVPROC gl3wGetQueryObjectuiv; +PFNGLGETQUERYIVPROC gl3wGetQueryiv; +PFNGLGETRENDERBUFFERPARAMETERIVPROC gl3wGetRenderbufferParameteriv; +PFNGLGETSAMPLERPARAMETERIIVPROC gl3wGetSamplerParameterIiv; +PFNGLGETSAMPLERPARAMETERIUIVPROC gl3wGetSamplerParameterIuiv; +PFNGLGETSAMPLERPARAMETERFVPROC gl3wGetSamplerParameterfv; +PFNGLGETSAMPLERPARAMETERIVPROC gl3wGetSamplerParameteriv; +PFNGLGETSHADERINFOLOGPROC gl3wGetShaderInfoLog; +PFNGLGETSHADERPRECISIONFORMATPROC gl3wGetShaderPrecisionFormat; +PFNGLGETSHADERSOURCEPROC gl3wGetShaderSource; +PFNGLGETSHADERIVPROC gl3wGetShaderiv; +PFNGLGETSTRINGPROC gl3wGetString; +PFNGLGETSTRINGIPROC gl3wGetStringi; +PFNGLGETSUBROUTINEINDEXPROC gl3wGetSubroutineIndex; +PFNGLGETSUBROUTINEUNIFORMLOCATIONPROC gl3wGetSubroutineUniformLocation; +PFNGLGETSYNCIVPROC gl3wGetSynciv; +PFNGLGETTEXIMAGEPROC gl3wGetTexImage; +PFNGLGETTEXLEVELPARAMETERFVPROC gl3wGetTexLevelParameterfv; +PFNGLGETTEXLEVELPARAMETERIVPROC gl3wGetTexLevelParameteriv; +PFNGLGETTEXPARAMETERIIVPROC gl3wGetTexParameterIiv; +PFNGLGETTEXPARAMETERIUIVPROC gl3wGetTexParameterIuiv; +PFNGLGETTEXPARAMETERFVPROC gl3wGetTexParameterfv; +PFNGLGETTEXPARAMETERIVPROC gl3wGetTexParameteriv; +PFNGLGETTEXTUREHANDLEARBPROC gl3wGetTextureHandleARB; +PFNGLGETTEXTUREIMAGEPROC gl3wGetTextureImage; +PFNGLGETTEXTURELEVELPARAMETERFVPROC gl3wGetTextureLevelParameterfv; +PFNGLGETTEXTURELEVELPARAMETERIVPROC gl3wGetTextureLevelParameteriv; +PFNGLGETTEXTUREPARAMETERIIVPROC gl3wGetTextureParameterIiv; +PFNGLGETTEXTUREPARAMETERIUIVPROC gl3wGetTextureParameterIuiv; +PFNGLGETTEXTUREPARAMETERFVPROC gl3wGetTextureParameterfv; +PFNGLGETTEXTUREPARAMETERIVPROC gl3wGetTextureParameteriv; +PFNGLGETTEXTURESAMPLERHANDLEARBPROC gl3wGetTextureSamplerHandleARB; +PFNGLGETTEXTURESUBIMAGEPROC gl3wGetTextureSubImage; +PFNGLGETTRANSFORMFEEDBACKVARYINGPROC gl3wGetTransformFeedbackVarying; +PFNGLGETTRANSFORMFEEDBACKI64_VPROC gl3wGetTransformFeedbacki64_v; +PFNGLGETTRANSFORMFEEDBACKI_VPROC gl3wGetTransformFeedbacki_v; +PFNGLGETTRANSFORMFEEDBACKIVPROC gl3wGetTransformFeedbackiv; +PFNGLGETUNIFORMBLOCKINDEXPROC gl3wGetUniformBlockIndex; +PFNGLGETUNIFORMINDICESPROC gl3wGetUniformIndices; +PFNGLGETUNIFORMLOCATIONPROC gl3wGetUniformLocation; +PFNGLGETUNIFORMSUBROUTINEUIVPROC gl3wGetUniformSubroutineuiv; +PFNGLGETUNIFORMDVPROC gl3wGetUniformdv; +PFNGLGETUNIFORMFVPROC gl3wGetUniformfv; +PFNGLGETUNIFORMIVPROC gl3wGetUniformiv; +PFNGLGETUNIFORMUIVPROC gl3wGetUniformuiv; +PFNGLGETVERTEXARRAYINDEXED64IVPROC gl3wGetVertexArrayIndexed64iv; +PFNGLGETVERTEXARRAYINDEXEDIVPROC gl3wGetVertexArrayIndexediv; +PFNGLGETVERTEXARRAYIVPROC gl3wGetVertexArrayiv; +PFNGLGETVERTEXATTRIBIIVPROC gl3wGetVertexAttribIiv; +PFNGLGETVERTEXATTRIBIUIVPROC gl3wGetVertexAttribIuiv; +PFNGLGETVERTEXATTRIBLDVPROC gl3wGetVertexAttribLdv; +PFNGLGETVERTEXATTRIBLUI64VARBPROC gl3wGetVertexAttribLui64vARB; +PFNGLGETVERTEXATTRIBPOINTERVPROC gl3wGetVertexAttribPointerv; +PFNGLGETVERTEXATTRIBDVPROC gl3wGetVertexAttribdv; +PFNGLGETVERTEXATTRIBFVPROC gl3wGetVertexAttribfv; +PFNGLGETVERTEXATTRIBIVPROC gl3wGetVertexAttribiv; +PFNGLGETNCOMPRESSEDTEXIMAGEPROC gl3wGetnCompressedTexImage; +PFNGLGETNCOMPRESSEDTEXIMAGEARBPROC gl3wGetnCompressedTexImageARB; +PFNGLGETNTEXIMAGEPROC gl3wGetnTexImage; +PFNGLGETNTEXIMAGEARBPROC gl3wGetnTexImageARB; +PFNGLGETNUNIFORMDVPROC gl3wGetnUniformdv; +PFNGLGETNUNIFORMDVARBPROC gl3wGetnUniformdvARB; +PFNGLGETNUNIFORMFVPROC gl3wGetnUniformfv; +PFNGLGETNUNIFORMFVARBPROC gl3wGetnUniformfvARB; +PFNGLGETNUNIFORMIVPROC gl3wGetnUniformiv; +PFNGLGETNUNIFORMIVARBPROC gl3wGetnUniformivARB; +PFNGLGETNUNIFORMUIVPROC gl3wGetnUniformuiv; +PFNGLGETNUNIFORMUIVARBPROC gl3wGetnUniformuivARB; +PFNGLHINTPROC gl3wHint; +PFNGLINVALIDATEBUFFERDATAPROC gl3wInvalidateBufferData; +PFNGLINVALIDATEBUFFERSUBDATAPROC gl3wInvalidateBufferSubData; +PFNGLINVALIDATEFRAMEBUFFERPROC gl3wInvalidateFramebuffer; +PFNGLINVALIDATENAMEDFRAMEBUFFERDATAPROC gl3wInvalidateNamedFramebufferData; +PFNGLINVALIDATENAMEDFRAMEBUFFERSUBDATAPROC gl3wInvalidateNamedFramebufferSubData; +PFNGLINVALIDATESUBFRAMEBUFFERPROC gl3wInvalidateSubFramebuffer; +PFNGLINVALIDATETEXIMAGEPROC gl3wInvalidateTexImage; +PFNGLINVALIDATETEXSUBIMAGEPROC gl3wInvalidateTexSubImage; +PFNGLISBUFFERPROC gl3wIsBuffer; +PFNGLISENABLEDPROC gl3wIsEnabled; +PFNGLISENABLEDIPROC gl3wIsEnabledi; +PFNGLISFRAMEBUFFERPROC gl3wIsFramebuffer; +PFNGLISIMAGEHANDLERESIDENTARBPROC gl3wIsImageHandleResidentARB; +PFNGLISNAMEDSTRINGARBPROC gl3wIsNamedStringARB; +PFNGLISPROGRAMPROC gl3wIsProgram; +PFNGLISPROGRAMPIPELINEPROC gl3wIsProgramPipeline; +PFNGLISQUERYPROC gl3wIsQuery; +PFNGLISRENDERBUFFERPROC gl3wIsRenderbuffer; +PFNGLISSAMPLERPROC gl3wIsSampler; +PFNGLISSHADERPROC gl3wIsShader; +PFNGLISSYNCPROC gl3wIsSync; +PFNGLISTEXTUREPROC gl3wIsTexture; +PFNGLISTEXTUREHANDLERESIDENTARBPROC gl3wIsTextureHandleResidentARB; +PFNGLISTRANSFORMFEEDBACKPROC gl3wIsTransformFeedback; +PFNGLISVERTEXARRAYPROC gl3wIsVertexArray; +PFNGLLINEWIDTHPROC gl3wLineWidth; +PFNGLLINKPROGRAMPROC gl3wLinkProgram; +PFNGLLOGICOPPROC gl3wLogicOp; +PFNGLMAKEIMAGEHANDLENONRESIDENTARBPROC gl3wMakeImageHandleNonResidentARB; +PFNGLMAKEIMAGEHANDLERESIDENTARBPROC gl3wMakeImageHandleResidentARB; +PFNGLMAKETEXTUREHANDLENONRESIDENTARBPROC gl3wMakeTextureHandleNonResidentARB; +PFNGLMAKETEXTUREHANDLERESIDENTARBPROC gl3wMakeTextureHandleResidentARB; +PFNGLMAPBUFFERPROC gl3wMapBuffer; +PFNGLMAPBUFFERRANGEPROC gl3wMapBufferRange; +PFNGLMAPNAMEDBUFFERPROC gl3wMapNamedBuffer; +PFNGLMAPNAMEDBUFFERRANGEPROC gl3wMapNamedBufferRange; +PFNGLMEMORYBARRIERPROC gl3wMemoryBarrier; +PFNGLMEMORYBARRIERBYREGIONPROC gl3wMemoryBarrierByRegion; +PFNGLMINSAMPLESHADINGPROC gl3wMinSampleShading; +PFNGLMINSAMPLESHADINGARBPROC gl3wMinSampleShadingARB; +PFNGLMULTIDRAWARRAYSPROC gl3wMultiDrawArrays; +PFNGLMULTIDRAWARRAYSINDIRECTPROC gl3wMultiDrawArraysIndirect; +PFNGLMULTIDRAWARRAYSINDIRECTCOUNTARBPROC gl3wMultiDrawArraysIndirectCountARB; +PFNGLMULTIDRAWELEMENTSPROC gl3wMultiDrawElements; +PFNGLMULTIDRAWELEMENTSBASEVERTEXPROC gl3wMultiDrawElementsBaseVertex; +PFNGLMULTIDRAWELEMENTSINDIRECTPROC gl3wMultiDrawElementsIndirect; +PFNGLMULTIDRAWELEMENTSINDIRECTCOUNTARBPROC gl3wMultiDrawElementsIndirectCountARB; +PFNGLNAMEDBUFFERDATAPROC gl3wNamedBufferData; +PFNGLNAMEDBUFFERPAGECOMMITMENTARBPROC gl3wNamedBufferPageCommitmentARB; +PFNGLNAMEDBUFFERPAGECOMMITMENTEXTPROC gl3wNamedBufferPageCommitmentEXT; +PFNGLNAMEDBUFFERSTORAGEPROC gl3wNamedBufferStorage; +PFNGLNAMEDBUFFERSUBDATAPROC gl3wNamedBufferSubData; +PFNGLNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERDRAWBUFFERPROC gl3wNamedFramebufferDrawBuffer; +PFNGLNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERDRAWBUFFERSPROC gl3wNamedFramebufferDrawBuffers; +PFNGLNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERPARAMETERIPROC gl3wNamedFramebufferParameteri; +PFNGLNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERREADBUFFERPROC gl3wNamedFramebufferReadBuffer; +PFNGLNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERRENDERBUFFERPROC gl3wNamedFramebufferRenderbuffer; +PFNGLNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERTEXTUREPROC gl3wNamedFramebufferTexture; +PFNGLNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERTEXTURELAYERPROC gl3wNamedFramebufferTextureLayer; +PFNGLNAMEDRENDERBUFFERSTORAGEPROC gl3wNamedRenderbufferStorage; +PFNGLNAMEDRENDERBUFFERSTORAGEMULTISAMPLEPROC gl3wNamedRenderbufferStorageMultisample; +PFNGLNAMEDSTRINGARBPROC gl3wNamedStringARB; +PFNGLOBJECTLABELPROC gl3wObjectLabel; +PFNGLOBJECTPTRLABELPROC gl3wObjectPtrLabel; +PFNGLPATCHPARAMETERFVPROC gl3wPatchParameterfv; +PFNGLPATCHPARAMETERIPROC gl3wPatchParameteri; +PFNGLPAUSETRANSFORMFEEDBACKPROC gl3wPauseTransformFeedback; +PFNGLPIXELSTOREFPROC gl3wPixelStoref; +PFNGLPIXELSTOREIPROC gl3wPixelStorei; +PFNGLPOINTPARAMETERFPROC gl3wPointParameterf; +PFNGLPOINTPARAMETERFVPROC gl3wPointParameterfv; +PFNGLPOINTPARAMETERIPROC gl3wPointParameteri; +PFNGLPOINTPARAMETERIVPROC gl3wPointParameteriv; +PFNGLPOINTSIZEPROC gl3wPointSize; +PFNGLPOLYGONMODEPROC gl3wPolygonMode; +PFNGLPOLYGONOFFSETPROC gl3wPolygonOffset; +PFNGLPOPDEBUGGROUPPROC gl3wPopDebugGroup; +PFNGLPRIMITIVERESTARTINDEXPROC gl3wPrimitiveRestartIndex; +PFNGLPROGRAMBINARYPROC gl3wProgramBinary; +PFNGLPROGRAMPARAMETERIPROC gl3wProgramParameteri; +PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM1DPROC gl3wProgramUniform1d; +PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM1DVPROC gl3wProgramUniform1dv; +PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM1FPROC gl3wProgramUniform1f; +PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM1FVPROC gl3wProgramUniform1fv; +PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM1IPROC gl3wProgramUniform1i; +PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM1IVPROC gl3wProgramUniform1iv; +PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM1UIPROC gl3wProgramUniform1ui; +PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM1UIVPROC gl3wProgramUniform1uiv; +PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM2DPROC gl3wProgramUniform2d; +PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM2DVPROC gl3wProgramUniform2dv; +PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM2FPROC gl3wProgramUniform2f; +PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM2FVPROC gl3wProgramUniform2fv; +PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM2IPROC gl3wProgramUniform2i; +PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM2IVPROC gl3wProgramUniform2iv; +PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM2UIPROC gl3wProgramUniform2ui; +PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM2UIVPROC gl3wProgramUniform2uiv; +PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM3DPROC gl3wProgramUniform3d; +PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM3DVPROC gl3wProgramUniform3dv; +PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM3FPROC gl3wProgramUniform3f; +PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM3FVPROC gl3wProgramUniform3fv; +PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM3IPROC gl3wProgramUniform3i; +PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM3IVPROC gl3wProgramUniform3iv; +PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM3UIPROC gl3wProgramUniform3ui; +PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM3UIVPROC gl3wProgramUniform3uiv; +PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM4DPROC gl3wProgramUniform4d; +PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM4DVPROC gl3wProgramUniform4dv; +PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM4FPROC gl3wProgramUniform4f; +PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM4FVPROC gl3wProgramUniform4fv; +PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM4IPROC gl3wProgramUniform4i; +PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM4IVPROC gl3wProgramUniform4iv; +PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM4UIPROC gl3wProgramUniform4ui; +PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM4UIVPROC gl3wProgramUniform4uiv; +PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMHANDLEUI64ARBPROC gl3wProgramUniformHandleui64ARB; +PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMHANDLEUI64VARBPROC gl3wProgramUniformHandleui64vARB; +PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX2DVPROC gl3wProgramUniformMatrix2dv; +PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX2FVPROC gl3wProgramUniformMatrix2fv; +PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX2X3DVPROC gl3wProgramUniformMatrix2x3dv; +PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX2X3FVPROC gl3wProgramUniformMatrix2x3fv; +PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX2X4DVPROC gl3wProgramUniformMatrix2x4dv; +PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX2X4FVPROC gl3wProgramUniformMatrix2x4fv; +PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX3DVPROC gl3wProgramUniformMatrix3dv; +PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX3FVPROC gl3wProgramUniformMatrix3fv; +PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX3X2DVPROC gl3wProgramUniformMatrix3x2dv; +PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX3X2FVPROC gl3wProgramUniformMatrix3x2fv; +PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX3X4DVPROC gl3wProgramUniformMatrix3x4dv; +PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX3X4FVPROC gl3wProgramUniformMatrix3x4fv; +PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX4DVPROC gl3wProgramUniformMatrix4dv; +PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX4FVPROC gl3wProgramUniformMatrix4fv; +PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX4X2DVPROC gl3wProgramUniformMatrix4x2dv; +PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX4X2FVPROC gl3wProgramUniformMatrix4x2fv; +PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX4X3DVPROC gl3wProgramUniformMatrix4x3dv; +PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX4X3FVPROC gl3wProgramUniformMatrix4x3fv; +PFNGLPROVOKINGVERTEXPROC gl3wProvokingVertex; +PFNGLPUSHDEBUGGROUPPROC gl3wPushDebugGroup; +PFNGLQUERYCOUNTERPROC gl3wQueryCounter; +PFNGLREADBUFFERPROC gl3wReadBuffer; +PFNGLREADPIXELSPROC gl3wReadPixels; +PFNGLREADNPIXELSPROC gl3wReadnPixels; +PFNGLREADNPIXELSARBPROC gl3wReadnPixelsARB; +PFNGLRELEASESHADERCOMPILERPROC gl3wReleaseShaderCompiler; +PFNGLRENDERBUFFERSTORAGEPROC gl3wRenderbufferStorage; +PFNGLRENDERBUFFERSTORAGEMULTISAMPLEPROC gl3wRenderbufferStorageMultisample; +PFNGLRESUMETRANSFORMFEEDBACKPROC gl3wResumeTransformFeedback; +PFNGLSAMPLECOVERAGEPROC gl3wSampleCoverage; +PFNGLSAMPLEMASKIPROC gl3wSampleMaski; +PFNGLSAMPLERPARAMETERIIVPROC gl3wSamplerParameterIiv; +PFNGLSAMPLERPARAMETERIUIVPROC gl3wSamplerParameterIuiv; +PFNGLSAMPLERPARAMETERFPROC gl3wSamplerParameterf; +PFNGLSAMPLERPARAMETERFVPROC gl3wSamplerParameterfv; +PFNGLSAMPLERPARAMETERIPROC gl3wSamplerParameteri; +PFNGLSAMPLERPARAMETERIVPROC gl3wSamplerParameteriv; +PFNGLSCISSORPROC gl3wScissor; +PFNGLSCISSORARRAYVPROC gl3wScissorArrayv; +PFNGLSCISSORINDEXEDPROC gl3wScissorIndexed; +PFNGLSCISSORINDEXEDVPROC gl3wScissorIndexedv; +PFNGLSHADERBINARYPROC gl3wShaderBinary; +PFNGLSHADERSOURCEPROC gl3wShaderSource; +PFNGLSHADERSTORAGEBLOCKBINDINGPROC gl3wShaderStorageBlockBinding; +PFNGLSTENCILFUNCPROC gl3wStencilFunc; +PFNGLSTENCILFUNCSEPARATEPROC gl3wStencilFuncSeparate; +PFNGLSTENCILMASKPROC gl3wStencilMask; +PFNGLSTENCILMASKSEPARATEPROC gl3wStencilMaskSeparate; +PFNGLSTENCILOPPROC gl3wStencilOp; +PFNGLSTENCILOPSEPARATEPROC gl3wStencilOpSeparate; +PFNGLTEXBUFFERPROC gl3wTexBuffer; +PFNGLTEXBUFFERRANGEPROC gl3wTexBufferRange; +PFNGLTEXIMAGE1DPROC gl3wTexImage1D; +PFNGLTEXIMAGE2DPROC gl3wTexImage2D; +PFNGLTEXIMAGE2DMULTISAMPLEPROC gl3wTexImage2DMultisample; +PFNGLTEXIMAGE3DPROC gl3wTexImage3D; +PFNGLTEXIMAGE3DMULTISAMPLEPROC gl3wTexImage3DMultisample; +PFNGLTEXPAGECOMMITMENTARBPROC gl3wTexPageCommitmentARB; +PFNGLTEXPARAMETERIIVPROC gl3wTexParameterIiv; +PFNGLTEXPARAMETERIUIVPROC gl3wTexParameterIuiv; +PFNGLTEXPARAMETERFPROC gl3wTexParameterf; +PFNGLTEXPARAMETERFVPROC gl3wTexParameterfv; +PFNGLTEXPARAMETERIPROC gl3wTexParameteri; +PFNGLTEXPARAMETERIVPROC gl3wTexParameteriv; +PFNGLTEXSTORAGE1DPROC gl3wTexStorage1D; +PFNGLTEXSTORAGE2DPROC gl3wTexStorage2D; +PFNGLTEXSTORAGE2DMULTISAMPLEPROC gl3wTexStorage2DMultisample; +PFNGLTEXSTORAGE3DPROC gl3wTexStorage3D; +PFNGLTEXSTORAGE3DMULTISAMPLEPROC gl3wTexStorage3DMultisample; +PFNGLTEXSUBIMAGE1DPROC gl3wTexSubImage1D; +PFNGLTEXSUBIMAGE2DPROC gl3wTexSubImage2D; +PFNGLTEXSUBIMAGE3DPROC gl3wTexSubImage3D; +PFNGLTEXTUREBARRIERPROC gl3wTextureBarrier; +PFNGLTEXTUREBUFFERPROC gl3wTextureBuffer; +PFNGLTEXTUREBUFFERRANGEPROC gl3wTextureBufferRange; +PFNGLTEXTUREPARAMETERIIVPROC gl3wTextureParameterIiv; +PFNGLTEXTUREPARAMETERIUIVPROC gl3wTextureParameterIuiv; +PFNGLTEXTUREPARAMETERFPROC gl3wTextureParameterf; +PFNGLTEXTUREPARAMETERFVPROC gl3wTextureParameterfv; +PFNGLTEXTUREPARAMETERIPROC gl3wTextureParameteri; +PFNGLTEXTUREPARAMETERIVPROC gl3wTextureParameteriv; +PFNGLTEXTURESTORAGE1DPROC gl3wTextureStorage1D; +PFNGLTEXTURESTORAGE2DPROC gl3wTextureStorage2D; +PFNGLTEXTURESTORAGE2DMULTISAMPLEPROC gl3wTextureStorage2DMultisample; +PFNGLTEXTURESTORAGE3DPROC gl3wTextureStorage3D; +PFNGLTEXTURESTORAGE3DMULTISAMPLEPROC gl3wTextureStorage3DMultisample; +PFNGLTEXTURESUBIMAGE1DPROC gl3wTextureSubImage1D; +PFNGLTEXTURESUBIMAGE2DPROC gl3wTextureSubImage2D; +PFNGLTEXTURESUBIMAGE3DPROC gl3wTextureSubImage3D; +PFNGLTEXTUREVIEWPROC gl3wTextureView; +PFNGLTRANSFORMFEEDBACKBUFFERBASEPROC gl3wTransformFeedbackBufferBase; +PFNGLTRANSFORMFEEDBACKBUFFERRANGEPROC gl3wTransformFeedbackBufferRange; +PFNGLTRANSFORMFEEDBACKVARYINGSPROC gl3wTransformFeedbackVaryings; +PFNGLUNIFORM1DPROC gl3wUniform1d; +PFNGLUNIFORM1DVPROC gl3wUniform1dv; +PFNGLUNIFORM1FPROC gl3wUniform1f; +PFNGLUNIFORM1FVPROC gl3wUniform1fv; +PFNGLUNIFORM1IPROC gl3wUniform1i; +PFNGLUNIFORM1IVPROC gl3wUniform1iv; +PFNGLUNIFORM1UIPROC gl3wUniform1ui; +PFNGLUNIFORM1UIVPROC gl3wUniform1uiv; +PFNGLUNIFORM2DPROC gl3wUniform2d; +PFNGLUNIFORM2DVPROC gl3wUniform2dv; +PFNGLUNIFORM2FPROC gl3wUniform2f; +PFNGLUNIFORM2FVPROC gl3wUniform2fv; +PFNGLUNIFORM2IPROC gl3wUniform2i; +PFNGLUNIFORM2IVPROC gl3wUniform2iv; +PFNGLUNIFORM2UIPROC gl3wUniform2ui; +PFNGLUNIFORM2UIVPROC gl3wUniform2uiv; +PFNGLUNIFORM3DPROC gl3wUniform3d; +PFNGLUNIFORM3DVPROC gl3wUniform3dv; +PFNGLUNIFORM3FPROC gl3wUniform3f; +PFNGLUNIFORM3FVPROC gl3wUniform3fv; +PFNGLUNIFORM3IPROC gl3wUniform3i; +PFNGLUNIFORM3IVPROC gl3wUniform3iv; +PFNGLUNIFORM3UIPROC gl3wUniform3ui; +PFNGLUNIFORM3UIVPROC gl3wUniform3uiv; +PFNGLUNIFORM4DPROC gl3wUniform4d; +PFNGLUNIFORM4DVPROC gl3wUniform4dv; +PFNGLUNIFORM4FPROC gl3wUniform4f; +PFNGLUNIFORM4FVPROC gl3wUniform4fv; +PFNGLUNIFORM4IPROC gl3wUniform4i; +PFNGLUNIFORM4IVPROC gl3wUniform4iv; +PFNGLUNIFORM4UIPROC gl3wUniform4ui; +PFNGLUNIFORM4UIVPROC gl3wUniform4uiv; +PFNGLUNIFORMBLOCKBINDINGPROC gl3wUniformBlockBinding; +PFNGLUNIFORMHANDLEUI64ARBPROC gl3wUniformHandleui64ARB; +PFNGLUNIFORMHANDLEUI64VARBPROC gl3wUniformHandleui64vARB; +PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX2DVPROC gl3wUniformMatrix2dv; +PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX2FVPROC gl3wUniformMatrix2fv; +PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX2X3DVPROC gl3wUniformMatrix2x3dv; +PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX2X3FVPROC gl3wUniformMatrix2x3fv; +PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX2X4DVPROC gl3wUniformMatrix2x4dv; +PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX2X4FVPROC gl3wUniformMatrix2x4fv; +PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX3DVPROC gl3wUniformMatrix3dv; +PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX3FVPROC gl3wUniformMatrix3fv; +PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX3X2DVPROC gl3wUniformMatrix3x2dv; +PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX3X2FVPROC gl3wUniformMatrix3x2fv; +PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX3X4DVPROC gl3wUniformMatrix3x4dv; +PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX3X4FVPROC gl3wUniformMatrix3x4fv; +PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX4DVPROC gl3wUniformMatrix4dv; +PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX4FVPROC gl3wUniformMatrix4fv; +PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX4X2DVPROC gl3wUniformMatrix4x2dv; +PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX4X2FVPROC gl3wUniformMatrix4x2fv; +PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX4X3DVPROC gl3wUniformMatrix4x3dv; +PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX4X3FVPROC gl3wUniformMatrix4x3fv; +PFNGLUNIFORMSUBROUTINESUIVPROC gl3wUniformSubroutinesuiv; +PFNGLUNMAPBUFFERPROC gl3wUnmapBuffer; +PFNGLUNMAPNAMEDBUFFERPROC gl3wUnmapNamedBuffer; +PFNGLUSEPROGRAMPROC gl3wUseProgram; +PFNGLUSEPROGRAMSTAGESPROC gl3wUseProgramStages; +PFNGLVALIDATEPROGRAMPROC gl3wValidateProgram; +PFNGLVALIDATEPROGRAMPIPELINEPROC gl3wValidateProgramPipeline; +PFNGLVERTEXARRAYATTRIBBINDINGPROC gl3wVertexArrayAttribBinding; +PFNGLVERTEXARRAYATTRIBFORMATPROC gl3wVertexArrayAttribFormat; +PFNGLVERTEXARRAYATTRIBIFORMATPROC gl3wVertexArrayAttribIFormat; +PFNGLVERTEXARRAYATTRIBLFORMATPROC gl3wVertexArrayAttribLFormat; +PFNGLVERTEXARRAYBINDINGDIVISORPROC gl3wVertexArrayBindingDivisor; +PFNGLVERTEXARRAYELEMENTBUFFERPROC gl3wVertexArrayElementBuffer; +PFNGLVERTEXARRAYVERTEXBUFFERPROC gl3wVertexArrayVertexBuffer; +PFNGLVERTEXARRAYVERTEXBUFFERSPROC gl3wVertexArrayVertexBuffers; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB1DPROC gl3wVertexAttrib1d; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB1DVPROC gl3wVertexAttrib1dv; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB1FPROC gl3wVertexAttrib1f; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB1FVPROC gl3wVertexAttrib1fv; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB1SPROC gl3wVertexAttrib1s; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB1SVPROC gl3wVertexAttrib1sv; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB2DPROC gl3wVertexAttrib2d; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB2DVPROC gl3wVertexAttrib2dv; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB2FPROC gl3wVertexAttrib2f; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB2FVPROC gl3wVertexAttrib2fv; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB2SPROC gl3wVertexAttrib2s; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB2SVPROC gl3wVertexAttrib2sv; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB3DPROC gl3wVertexAttrib3d; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB3DVPROC gl3wVertexAttrib3dv; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB3FPROC gl3wVertexAttrib3f; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB3FVPROC gl3wVertexAttrib3fv; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB3SPROC gl3wVertexAttrib3s; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB3SVPROC gl3wVertexAttrib3sv; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4NBVPROC gl3wVertexAttrib4Nbv; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4NIVPROC gl3wVertexAttrib4Niv; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4NSVPROC gl3wVertexAttrib4Nsv; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4NUBPROC gl3wVertexAttrib4Nub; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4NUBVPROC gl3wVertexAttrib4Nubv; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4NUIVPROC gl3wVertexAttrib4Nuiv; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4NUSVPROC gl3wVertexAttrib4Nusv; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4BVPROC gl3wVertexAttrib4bv; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4DPROC gl3wVertexAttrib4d; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4DVPROC gl3wVertexAttrib4dv; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4FPROC gl3wVertexAttrib4f; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4FVPROC gl3wVertexAttrib4fv; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4IVPROC gl3wVertexAttrib4iv; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4SPROC gl3wVertexAttrib4s; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4SVPROC gl3wVertexAttrib4sv; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4UBVPROC gl3wVertexAttrib4ubv; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4UIVPROC gl3wVertexAttrib4uiv; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4USVPROC gl3wVertexAttrib4usv; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBBINDINGPROC gl3wVertexAttribBinding; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBDIVISORPROC gl3wVertexAttribDivisor; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBFORMATPROC gl3wVertexAttribFormat; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI1IPROC gl3wVertexAttribI1i; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI1IVPROC gl3wVertexAttribI1iv; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI1UIPROC gl3wVertexAttribI1ui; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI1UIVPROC gl3wVertexAttribI1uiv; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI2IPROC gl3wVertexAttribI2i; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI2IVPROC gl3wVertexAttribI2iv; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI2UIPROC gl3wVertexAttribI2ui; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI2UIVPROC gl3wVertexAttribI2uiv; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI3IPROC gl3wVertexAttribI3i; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI3IVPROC gl3wVertexAttribI3iv; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI3UIPROC gl3wVertexAttribI3ui; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI3UIVPROC gl3wVertexAttribI3uiv; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI4BVPROC gl3wVertexAttribI4bv; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI4IPROC gl3wVertexAttribI4i; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI4IVPROC gl3wVertexAttribI4iv; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI4SVPROC gl3wVertexAttribI4sv; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI4UBVPROC gl3wVertexAttribI4ubv; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI4UIPROC gl3wVertexAttribI4ui; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI4UIVPROC gl3wVertexAttribI4uiv; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI4USVPROC gl3wVertexAttribI4usv; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBIFORMATPROC gl3wVertexAttribIFormat; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBIPOINTERPROC gl3wVertexAttribIPointer; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBL1DPROC gl3wVertexAttribL1d; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBL1DVPROC gl3wVertexAttribL1dv; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBL1UI64ARBPROC gl3wVertexAttribL1ui64ARB; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBL1UI64VARBPROC gl3wVertexAttribL1ui64vARB; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBL2DPROC gl3wVertexAttribL2d; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBL2DVPROC gl3wVertexAttribL2dv; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBL3DPROC gl3wVertexAttribL3d; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBL3DVPROC gl3wVertexAttribL3dv; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBL4DPROC gl3wVertexAttribL4d; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBL4DVPROC gl3wVertexAttribL4dv; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBLFORMATPROC gl3wVertexAttribLFormat; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBLPOINTERPROC gl3wVertexAttribLPointer; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBP1UIPROC gl3wVertexAttribP1ui; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBP1UIVPROC gl3wVertexAttribP1uiv; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBP2UIPROC gl3wVertexAttribP2ui; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBP2UIVPROC gl3wVertexAttribP2uiv; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBP3UIPROC gl3wVertexAttribP3ui; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBP3UIVPROC gl3wVertexAttribP3uiv; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBP4UIPROC gl3wVertexAttribP4ui; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBP4UIVPROC gl3wVertexAttribP4uiv; +PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBPOINTERPROC gl3wVertexAttribPointer; +PFNGLVERTEXBINDINGDIVISORPROC gl3wVertexBindingDivisor; +PFNGLVIEWPORTPROC gl3wViewport; +PFNGLVIEWPORTARRAYVPROC gl3wViewportArrayv; +PFNGLVIEWPORTINDEXEDFPROC gl3wViewportIndexedf; +PFNGLVIEWPORTINDEXEDFVPROC gl3wViewportIndexedfv; +PFNGLWAITSYNCPROC gl3wWaitSync; + +static void load_procs(void) +{ + gl3wActiveShaderProgram = (PFNGLACTIVESHADERPROGRAMPROC) get_proc("glActiveShaderProgram"); + gl3wActiveTexture = (PFNGLACTIVETEXTUREPROC) get_proc("glActiveTexture"); + gl3wAttachShader = (PFNGLATTACHSHADERPROC) get_proc("glAttachShader"); + gl3wBeginConditionalRender = (PFNGLBEGINCONDITIONALRENDERPROC) get_proc("glBeginConditionalRender"); + gl3wBeginQuery = (PFNGLBEGINQUERYPROC) get_proc("glBeginQuery"); + gl3wBeginQueryIndexed = (PFNGLBEGINQUERYINDEXEDPROC) get_proc("glBeginQueryIndexed"); + gl3wBeginTransformFeedback = (PFNGLBEGINTRANSFORMFEEDBACKPROC) get_proc("glBeginTransformFeedback"); + gl3wBindAttribLocation = (PFNGLBINDATTRIBLOCATIONPROC) get_proc("glBindAttribLocation"); + gl3wBindBuffer = (PFNGLBINDBUFFERPROC) get_proc("glBindBuffer"); + gl3wBindBufferBase = (PFNGLBINDBUFFERBASEPROC) get_proc("glBindBufferBase"); + gl3wBindBufferRange = (PFNGLBINDBUFFERRANGEPROC) get_proc("glBindBufferRange"); + gl3wBindBuffersBase = (PFNGLBINDBUFFERSBASEPROC) get_proc("glBindBuffersBase"); + gl3wBindBuffersRange = (PFNGLBINDBUFFERSRANGEPROC) get_proc("glBindBuffersRange"); + gl3wBindFragDataLocation = (PFNGLBINDFRAGDATALOCATIONPROC) get_proc("glBindFragDataLocation"); + gl3wBindFragDataLocationIndexed = (PFNGLBINDFRAGDATALOCATIONINDEXEDPROC) get_proc("glBindFragDataLocationIndexed"); + gl3wBindFramebuffer = (PFNGLBINDFRAMEBUFFERPROC) get_proc("glBindFramebuffer"); + gl3wBindImageTexture = (PFNGLBINDIMAGETEXTUREPROC) get_proc("glBindImageTexture"); + gl3wBindImageTextures = (PFNGLBINDIMAGETEXTURESPROC) get_proc("glBindImageTextures"); + gl3wBindProgramPipeline = (PFNGLBINDPROGRAMPIPELINEPROC) get_proc("glBindProgramPipeline"); + gl3wBindRenderbuffer = (PFNGLBINDRENDERBUFFERPROC) get_proc("glBindRenderbuffer"); + gl3wBindSampler = (PFNGLBINDSAMPLERPROC) get_proc("glBindSampler"); + gl3wBindSamplers = (PFNGLBINDSAMPLERSPROC) get_proc("glBindSamplers"); + gl3wBindTexture = (PFNGLBINDTEXTUREPROC) get_proc("glBindTexture"); + gl3wBindTextureUnit = (PFNGLBINDTEXTUREUNITPROC) get_proc("glBindTextureUnit"); + gl3wBindTextures = (PFNGLBINDTEXTURESPROC) get_proc("glBindTextures"); + gl3wBindTransformFeedback = (PFNGLBINDTRANSFORMFEEDBACKPROC) get_proc("glBindTransformFeedback"); + gl3wBindVertexArray = (PFNGLBINDVERTEXARRAYPROC) get_proc("glBindVertexArray"); + gl3wBindVertexBuffer = (PFNGLBINDVERTEXBUFFERPROC) get_proc("glBindVertexBuffer"); + gl3wBindVertexBuffers = (PFNGLBINDVERTEXBUFFERSPROC) get_proc("glBindVertexBuffers"); + gl3wBlendColor = (PFNGLBLENDCOLORPROC) get_proc("glBlendColor"); + gl3wBlendEquation = (PFNGLBLENDEQUATIONPROC) get_proc("glBlendEquation"); + gl3wBlendEquationSeparate = (PFNGLBLENDEQUATIONSEPARATEPROC) get_proc("glBlendEquationSeparate"); + gl3wBlendEquationSeparatei = (PFNGLBLENDEQUATIONSEPARATEIPROC) get_proc("glBlendEquationSeparatei"); + gl3wBlendEquationSeparateiARB = (PFNGLBLENDEQUATIONSEPARATEIARBPROC) get_proc("glBlendEquationSeparateiARB"); + gl3wBlendEquationi = (PFNGLBLENDEQUATIONIPROC) get_proc("glBlendEquationi"); + gl3wBlendEquationiARB = (PFNGLBLENDEQUATIONIARBPROC) get_proc("glBlendEquationiARB"); + gl3wBlendFunc = (PFNGLBLENDFUNCPROC) get_proc("glBlendFunc"); + gl3wBlendFuncSeparate = (PFNGLBLENDFUNCSEPARATEPROC) get_proc("glBlendFuncSeparate"); + gl3wBlendFuncSeparatei = (PFNGLBLENDFUNCSEPARATEIPROC) get_proc("glBlendFuncSeparatei"); + gl3wBlendFuncSeparateiARB = (PFNGLBLENDFUNCSEPARATEIARBPROC) get_proc("glBlendFuncSeparateiARB"); + gl3wBlendFunci = (PFNGLBLENDFUNCIPROC) get_proc("glBlendFunci"); + gl3wBlendFunciARB = (PFNGLBLENDFUNCIARBPROC) get_proc("glBlendFunciARB"); + gl3wBlitFramebuffer = (PFNGLBLITFRAMEBUFFERPROC) get_proc("glBlitFramebuffer"); + gl3wBlitNamedFramebuffer = (PFNGLBLITNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERPROC) get_proc("glBlitNamedFramebuffer"); + gl3wBufferData = (PFNGLBUFFERDATAPROC) get_proc("glBufferData"); + gl3wBufferPageCommitmentARB = (PFNGLBUFFERPAGECOMMITMENTARBPROC) get_proc("glBufferPageCommitmentARB"); + gl3wBufferStorage = (PFNGLBUFFERSTORAGEPROC) get_proc("glBufferStorage"); + gl3wBufferSubData = (PFNGLBUFFERSUBDATAPROC) get_proc("glBufferSubData"); + gl3wCheckFramebufferStatus = (PFNGLCHECKFRAMEBUFFERSTATUSPROC) get_proc("glCheckFramebufferStatus"); + gl3wCheckNamedFramebufferStatus = (PFNGLCHECKNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERSTATUSPROC) get_proc("glCheckNamedFramebufferStatus"); + gl3wClampColor = (PFNGLCLAMPCOLORPROC) get_proc("glClampColor"); + gl3wClear = (PFNGLCLEARPROC) get_proc("glClear"); + gl3wClearBufferData = (PFNGLCLEARBUFFERDATAPROC) get_proc("glClearBufferData"); + gl3wClearBufferSubData = (PFNGLCLEARBUFFERSUBDATAPROC) get_proc("glClearBufferSubData"); + gl3wClearBufferfi = (PFNGLCLEARBUFFERFIPROC) get_proc("glClearBufferfi"); + gl3wClearBufferfv = (PFNGLCLEARBUFFERFVPROC) get_proc("glClearBufferfv"); + gl3wClearBufferiv = (PFNGLCLEARBUFFERIVPROC) get_proc("glClearBufferiv"); + gl3wClearBufferuiv = (PFNGLCLEARBUFFERUIVPROC) get_proc("glClearBufferuiv"); + gl3wClearColor = (PFNGLCLEARCOLORPROC) get_proc("glClearColor"); + gl3wClearDepth = (PFNGLCLEARDEPTHPROC) get_proc("glClearDepth"); + gl3wClearDepthf = (PFNGLCLEARDEPTHFPROC) get_proc("glClearDepthf"); + gl3wClearNamedBufferData = (PFNGLCLEARNAMEDBUFFERDATAPROC) get_proc("glClearNamedBufferData"); + gl3wClearNamedBufferSubData = (PFNGLCLEARNAMEDBUFFERSUBDATAPROC) get_proc("glClearNamedBufferSubData"); + gl3wClearNamedFramebufferfi = (PFNGLCLEARNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERFIPROC) get_proc("glClearNamedFramebufferfi"); + gl3wClearNamedFramebufferfv = (PFNGLCLEARNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERFVPROC) get_proc("glClearNamedFramebufferfv"); + gl3wClearNamedFramebufferiv = (PFNGLCLEARNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERIVPROC) get_proc("glClearNamedFramebufferiv"); + gl3wClearNamedFramebufferuiv = (PFNGLCLEARNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERUIVPROC) get_proc("glClearNamedFramebufferuiv"); + gl3wClearStencil = (PFNGLCLEARSTENCILPROC) get_proc("glClearStencil"); + gl3wClearTexImage = (PFNGLCLEARTEXIMAGEPROC) get_proc("glClearTexImage"); + gl3wClearTexSubImage = (PFNGLCLEARTEXSUBIMAGEPROC) get_proc("glClearTexSubImage"); + gl3wClientWaitSync = (PFNGLCLIENTWAITSYNCPROC) get_proc("glClientWaitSync"); + gl3wClipControl = (PFNGLCLIPCONTROLPROC) get_proc("glClipControl"); + gl3wColorMask = (PFNGLCOLORMASKPROC) get_proc("glColorMask"); + gl3wColorMaski = (PFNGLCOLORMASKIPROC) get_proc("glColorMaski"); + gl3wCompileShader = (PFNGLCOMPILESHADERPROC) get_proc("glCompileShader"); + gl3wCompileShaderIncludeARB = (PFNGLCOMPILESHADERINCLUDEARBPROC) get_proc("glCompileShaderIncludeARB"); + gl3wCompressedTexImage1D = (PFNGLCOMPRESSEDTEXIMAGE1DPROC) get_proc("glCompressedTexImage1D"); + gl3wCompressedTexImage2D = (PFNGLCOMPRESSEDTEXIMAGE2DPROC) get_proc("glCompressedTexImage2D"); + gl3wCompressedTexImage3D = (PFNGLCOMPRESSEDTEXIMAGE3DPROC) get_proc("glCompressedTexImage3D"); + gl3wCompressedTexSubImage1D = (PFNGLCOMPRESSEDTEXSUBIMAGE1DPROC) get_proc("glCompressedTexSubImage1D"); + gl3wCompressedTexSubImage2D = (PFNGLCOMPRESSEDTEXSUBIMAGE2DPROC) get_proc("glCompressedTexSubImage2D"); + gl3wCompressedTexSubImage3D = (PFNGLCOMPRESSEDTEXSUBIMAGE3DPROC) get_proc("glCompressedTexSubImage3D"); + gl3wCompressedTextureSubImage1D = (PFNGLCOMPRESSEDTEXTURESUBIMAGE1DPROC) get_proc("glCompressedTextureSubImage1D"); + gl3wCompressedTextureSubImage2D = (PFNGLCOMPRESSEDTEXTURESUBIMAGE2DPROC) get_proc("glCompressedTextureSubImage2D"); + gl3wCompressedTextureSubImage3D = (PFNGLCOMPRESSEDTEXTURESUBIMAGE3DPROC) get_proc("glCompressedTextureSubImage3D"); + gl3wCopyBufferSubData = (PFNGLCOPYBUFFERSUBDATAPROC) get_proc("glCopyBufferSubData"); + gl3wCopyImageSubData = (PFNGLCOPYIMAGESUBDATAPROC) get_proc("glCopyImageSubData"); + gl3wCopyNamedBufferSubData = (PFNGLCOPYNAMEDBUFFERSUBDATAPROC) get_proc("glCopyNamedBufferSubData"); + gl3wCopyTexImage1D = (PFNGLCOPYTEXIMAGE1DPROC) get_proc("glCopyTexImage1D"); + gl3wCopyTexImage2D = (PFNGLCOPYTEXIMAGE2DPROC) get_proc("glCopyTexImage2D"); + gl3wCopyTexSubImage1D = (PFNGLCOPYTEXSUBIMAGE1DPROC) get_proc("glCopyTexSubImage1D"); + gl3wCopyTexSubImage2D = (PFNGLCOPYTEXSUBIMAGE2DPROC) get_proc("glCopyTexSubImage2D"); + gl3wCopyTexSubImage3D = (PFNGLCOPYTEXSUBIMAGE3DPROC) get_proc("glCopyTexSubImage3D"); + gl3wCopyTextureSubImage1D = (PFNGLCOPYTEXTURESUBIMAGE1DPROC) get_proc("glCopyTextureSubImage1D"); + gl3wCopyTextureSubImage2D = (PFNGLCOPYTEXTURESUBIMAGE2DPROC) get_proc("glCopyTextureSubImage2D"); + gl3wCopyTextureSubImage3D = (PFNGLCOPYTEXTURESUBIMAGE3DPROC) get_proc("glCopyTextureSubImage3D"); + gl3wCreateBuffers = (PFNGLCREATEBUFFERSPROC) get_proc("glCreateBuffers"); + gl3wCreateFramebuffers = (PFNGLCREATEFRAMEBUFFERSPROC) get_proc("glCreateFramebuffers"); + gl3wCreateProgram = (PFNGLCREATEPROGRAMPROC) get_proc("glCreateProgram"); + gl3wCreateProgramPipelines = (PFNGLCREATEPROGRAMPIPELINESPROC) get_proc("glCreateProgramPipelines"); + gl3wCreateQueries = (PFNGLCREATEQUERIESPROC) get_proc("glCreateQueries"); + gl3wCreateRenderbuffers = (PFNGLCREATERENDERBUFFERSPROC) get_proc("glCreateRenderbuffers"); + gl3wCreateSamplers = (PFNGLCREATESAMPLERSPROC) get_proc("glCreateSamplers"); + gl3wCreateShader = (PFNGLCREATESHADERPROC) get_proc("glCreateShader"); + gl3wCreateShaderProgramv = (PFNGLCREATESHADERPROGRAMVPROC) get_proc("glCreateShaderProgramv"); + gl3wCreateSyncFromCLeventARB = (PFNGLCREATESYNCFROMCLEVENTARBPROC) get_proc("glCreateSyncFromCLeventARB"); + gl3wCreateTextures = (PFNGLCREATETEXTURESPROC) get_proc("glCreateTextures"); + gl3wCreateTransformFeedbacks = (PFNGLCREATETRANSFORMFEEDBACKSPROC) get_proc("glCreateTransformFeedbacks"); + gl3wCreateVertexArrays = (PFNGLCREATEVERTEXARRAYSPROC) get_proc("glCreateVertexArrays"); + gl3wCullFace = (PFNGLCULLFACEPROC) get_proc("glCullFace"); + gl3wDebugMessageCallback = (PFNGLDEBUGMESSAGECALLBACKPROC) get_proc("glDebugMessageCallback"); + gl3wDebugMessageCallbackARB = (PFNGLDEBUGMESSAGECALLBACKARBPROC) get_proc("glDebugMessageCallbackARB"); + gl3wDebugMessageControl = (PFNGLDEBUGMESSAGECONTROLPROC) get_proc("glDebugMessageControl"); + gl3wDebugMessageControlARB = (PFNGLDEBUGMESSAGECONTROLARBPROC) get_proc("glDebugMessageControlARB"); + gl3wDebugMessageInsert = (PFNGLDEBUGMESSAGEINSERTPROC) get_proc("glDebugMessageInsert"); + gl3wDebugMessageInsertARB = (PFNGLDEBUGMESSAGEINSERTARBPROC) get_proc("glDebugMessageInsertARB"); + gl3wDeleteBuffers = (PFNGLDELETEBUFFERSPROC) get_proc("glDeleteBuffers"); + gl3wDeleteFramebuffers = (PFNGLDELETEFRAMEBUFFERSPROC) get_proc("glDeleteFramebuffers"); + gl3wDeleteNamedStringARB = (PFNGLDELETENAMEDSTRINGARBPROC) get_proc("glDeleteNamedStringARB"); + gl3wDeleteProgram = (PFNGLDELETEPROGRAMPROC) get_proc("glDeleteProgram"); + gl3wDeleteProgramPipelines = (PFNGLDELETEPROGRAMPIPELINESPROC) get_proc("glDeleteProgramPipelines"); + gl3wDeleteQueries = (PFNGLDELETEQUERIESPROC) get_proc("glDeleteQueries"); + gl3wDeleteRenderbuffers = (PFNGLDELETERENDERBUFFERSPROC) get_proc("glDeleteRenderbuffers"); + gl3wDeleteSamplers = (PFNGLDELETESAMPLERSPROC) get_proc("glDeleteSamplers"); + gl3wDeleteShader = (PFNGLDELETESHADERPROC) get_proc("glDeleteShader"); + gl3wDeleteSync = (PFNGLDELETESYNCPROC) get_proc("glDeleteSync"); + gl3wDeleteTextures = (PFNGLDELETETEXTURESPROC) get_proc("glDeleteTextures"); + gl3wDeleteTransformFeedbacks = (PFNGLDELETETRANSFORMFEEDBACKSPROC) get_proc("glDeleteTransformFeedbacks"); + gl3wDeleteVertexArrays = (PFNGLDELETEVERTEXARRAYSPROC) get_proc("glDeleteVertexArrays"); + gl3wDepthFunc = (PFNGLDEPTHFUNCPROC) get_proc("glDepthFunc"); + gl3wDepthMask = (PFNGLDEPTHMASKPROC) get_proc("glDepthMask"); + gl3wDepthRange = (PFNGLDEPTHRANGEPROC) get_proc("glDepthRange"); + gl3wDepthRangeArrayv = (PFNGLDEPTHRANGEARRAYVPROC) get_proc("glDepthRangeArrayv"); + gl3wDepthRangeIndexed = (PFNGLDEPTHRANGEINDEXEDPROC) get_proc("glDepthRangeIndexed"); + gl3wDepthRangef = (PFNGLDEPTHRANGEFPROC) get_proc("glDepthRangef"); + gl3wDetachShader = (PFNGLDETACHSHADERPROC) get_proc("glDetachShader"); + gl3wDisable = (PFNGLDISABLEPROC) get_proc("glDisable"); + gl3wDisableVertexArrayAttrib = (PFNGLDISABLEVERTEXARRAYATTRIBPROC) get_proc("glDisableVertexArrayAttrib"); + gl3wDisableVertexAttribArray = (PFNGLDISABLEVERTEXATTRIBARRAYPROC) get_proc("glDisableVertexAttribArray"); + gl3wDisablei = (PFNGLDISABLEIPROC) get_proc("glDisablei"); + gl3wDispatchCompute = (PFNGLDISPATCHCOMPUTEPROC) get_proc("glDispatchCompute"); + gl3wDispatchComputeGroupSizeARB = (PFNGLDISPATCHCOMPUTEGROUPSIZEARBPROC) get_proc("glDispatchComputeGroupSizeARB"); + gl3wDispatchComputeIndirect = (PFNGLDISPATCHCOMPUTEINDIRECTPROC) get_proc("glDispatchComputeIndirect"); + gl3wDrawArrays = (PFNGLDRAWARRAYSPROC) get_proc("glDrawArrays"); + gl3wDrawArraysIndirect = (PFNGLDRAWARRAYSINDIRECTPROC) get_proc("glDrawArraysIndirect"); + gl3wDrawArraysInstanced = (PFNGLDRAWARRAYSINSTANCEDPROC) get_proc("glDrawArraysInstanced"); + gl3wDrawArraysInstancedBaseInstance = (PFNGLDRAWARRAYSINSTANCEDBASEINSTANCEPROC) get_proc("glDrawArraysInstancedBaseInstance"); + gl3wDrawBuffer = (PFNGLDRAWBUFFERPROC) get_proc("glDrawBuffer"); + gl3wDrawBuffers = (PFNGLDRAWBUFFERSPROC) get_proc("glDrawBuffers"); + gl3wDrawElements = (PFNGLDRAWELEMENTSPROC) get_proc("glDrawElements"); + gl3wDrawElementsBaseVertex = (PFNGLDRAWELEMENTSBASEVERTEXPROC) get_proc("glDrawElementsBaseVertex"); + gl3wDrawElementsIndirect = (PFNGLDRAWELEMENTSINDIRECTPROC) get_proc("glDrawElementsIndirect"); + gl3wDrawElementsInstanced = (PFNGLDRAWELEMENTSINSTANCEDPROC) get_proc("glDrawElementsInstanced"); + gl3wDrawElementsInstancedBaseInstance = (PFNGLDRAWELEMENTSINSTANCEDBASEINSTANCEPROC) get_proc("glDrawElementsInstancedBaseInstance"); + gl3wDrawElementsInstancedBaseVertex = (PFNGLDRAWELEMENTSINSTANCEDBASEVERTEXPROC) get_proc("glDrawElementsInstancedBaseVertex"); + gl3wDrawElementsInstancedBaseVertexBaseInstance = (PFNGLDRAWELEMENTSINSTANCEDBASEVERTEXBASEINSTANCEPROC) get_proc("glDrawElementsInstancedBaseVertexBaseInstance"); + gl3wDrawRangeElements = (PFNGLDRAWRANGEELEMENTSPROC) get_proc("glDrawRangeElements"); + gl3wDrawRangeElementsBaseVertex = (PFNGLDRAWRANGEELEMENTSBASEVERTEXPROC) get_proc("glDrawRangeElementsBaseVertex"); + gl3wDrawTransformFeedback = (PFNGLDRAWTRANSFORMFEEDBACKPROC) get_proc("glDrawTransformFeedback"); + gl3wDrawTransformFeedbackInstanced = (PFNGLDRAWTRANSFORMFEEDBACKINSTANCEDPROC) get_proc("glDrawTransformFeedbackInstanced"); + gl3wDrawTransformFeedbackStream = (PFNGLDRAWTRANSFORMFEEDBACKSTREAMPROC) get_proc("glDrawTransformFeedbackStream"); + gl3wDrawTransformFeedbackStreamInstanced = (PFNGLDRAWTRANSFORMFEEDBACKSTREAMINSTANCEDPROC) get_proc("glDrawTransformFeedbackStreamInstanced"); + gl3wEnable = (PFNGLENABLEPROC) get_proc("glEnable"); + gl3wEnableVertexArrayAttrib = (PFNGLENABLEVERTEXARRAYATTRIBPROC) get_proc("glEnableVertexArrayAttrib"); + gl3wEnableVertexAttribArray = (PFNGLENABLEVERTEXATTRIBARRAYPROC) get_proc("glEnableVertexAttribArray"); + gl3wEnablei = (PFNGLENABLEIPROC) get_proc("glEnablei"); + gl3wEndConditionalRender = (PFNGLENDCONDITIONALRENDERPROC) get_proc("glEndConditionalRender"); + gl3wEndQuery = (PFNGLENDQUERYPROC) get_proc("glEndQuery"); + gl3wEndQueryIndexed = (PFNGLENDQUERYINDEXEDPROC) get_proc("glEndQueryIndexed"); + gl3wEndTransformFeedback = (PFNGLENDTRANSFORMFEEDBACKPROC) get_proc("glEndTransformFeedback"); + gl3wFenceSync = (PFNGLFENCESYNCPROC) get_proc("glFenceSync"); + gl3wFinish = (PFNGLFINISHPROC) get_proc("glFinish"); + gl3wFlush = (PFNGLFLUSHPROC) get_proc("glFlush"); + gl3wFlushMappedBufferRange = (PFNGLFLUSHMAPPEDBUFFERRANGEPROC) get_proc("glFlushMappedBufferRange"); + gl3wFlushMappedNamedBufferRange = (PFNGLFLUSHMAPPEDNAMEDBUFFERRANGEPROC) get_proc("glFlushMappedNamedBufferRange"); + gl3wFramebufferParameteri = (PFNGLFRAMEBUFFERPARAMETERIPROC) get_proc("glFramebufferParameteri"); + gl3wFramebufferRenderbuffer = (PFNGLFRAMEBUFFERRENDERBUFFERPROC) get_proc("glFramebufferRenderbuffer"); + gl3wFramebufferTexture = (PFNGLFRAMEBUFFERTEXTUREPROC) get_proc("glFramebufferTexture"); + gl3wFramebufferTexture1D = (PFNGLFRAMEBUFFERTEXTURE1DPROC) get_proc("glFramebufferTexture1D"); + gl3wFramebufferTexture2D = (PFNGLFRAMEBUFFERTEXTURE2DPROC) get_proc("glFramebufferTexture2D"); + gl3wFramebufferTexture3D = (PFNGLFRAMEBUFFERTEXTURE3DPROC) get_proc("glFramebufferTexture3D"); + gl3wFramebufferTextureLayer = (PFNGLFRAMEBUFFERTEXTURELAYERPROC) get_proc("glFramebufferTextureLayer"); + gl3wFrontFace = (PFNGLFRONTFACEPROC) get_proc("glFrontFace"); + gl3wGenBuffers = (PFNGLGENBUFFERSPROC) get_proc("glGenBuffers"); + gl3wGenFramebuffers = (PFNGLGENFRAMEBUFFERSPROC) get_proc("glGenFramebuffers"); + gl3wGenProgramPipelines = (PFNGLGENPROGRAMPIPELINESPROC) get_proc("glGenProgramPipelines"); + gl3wGenQueries = (PFNGLGENQUERIESPROC) get_proc("glGenQueries"); + gl3wGenRenderbuffers = (PFNGLGENRENDERBUFFERSPROC) get_proc("glGenRenderbuffers"); + gl3wGenSamplers = (PFNGLGENSAMPLERSPROC) get_proc("glGenSamplers"); + gl3wGenTextures = (PFNGLGENTEXTURESPROC) get_proc("glGenTextures"); + gl3wGenTransformFeedbacks = (PFNGLGENTRANSFORMFEEDBACKSPROC) get_proc("glGenTransformFeedbacks"); + gl3wGenVertexArrays = (PFNGLGENVERTEXARRAYSPROC) get_proc("glGenVertexArrays"); + gl3wGenerateMipmap = (PFNGLGENERATEMIPMAPPROC) get_proc("glGenerateMipmap"); + gl3wGenerateTextureMipmap = (PFNGLGENERATETEXTUREMIPMAPPROC) get_proc("glGenerateTextureMipmap"); + gl3wGetActiveAtomicCounterBufferiv = (PFNGLGETACTIVEATOMICCOUNTERBUFFERIVPROC) get_proc("glGetActiveAtomicCounterBufferiv"); + gl3wGetActiveAttrib = (PFNGLGETACTIVEATTRIBPROC) get_proc("glGetActiveAttrib"); + gl3wGetActiveSubroutineName = (PFNGLGETACTIVESUBROUTINENAMEPROC) get_proc("glGetActiveSubroutineName"); + gl3wGetActiveSubroutineUniformName = (PFNGLGETACTIVESUBROUTINEUNIFORMNAMEPROC) get_proc("glGetActiveSubroutineUniformName"); + gl3wGetActiveSubroutineUniformiv = (PFNGLGETACTIVESUBROUTINEUNIFORMIVPROC) get_proc("glGetActiveSubroutineUniformiv"); + gl3wGetActiveUniform = (PFNGLGETACTIVEUNIFORMPROC) get_proc("glGetActiveUniform"); + gl3wGetActiveUniformBlockName = (PFNGLGETACTIVEUNIFORMBLOCKNAMEPROC) get_proc("glGetActiveUniformBlockName"); + gl3wGetActiveUniformBlockiv = (PFNGLGETACTIVEUNIFORMBLOCKIVPROC) get_proc("glGetActiveUniformBlockiv"); + gl3wGetActiveUniformName = (PFNGLGETACTIVEUNIFORMNAMEPROC) get_proc("glGetActiveUniformName"); + gl3wGetActiveUniformsiv = (PFNGLGETACTIVEUNIFORMSIVPROC) get_proc("glGetActiveUniformsiv"); + gl3wGetAttachedShaders = (PFNGLGETATTACHEDSHADERSPROC) get_proc("glGetAttachedShaders"); + gl3wGetAttribLocation = (PFNGLGETATTRIBLOCATIONPROC) get_proc("glGetAttribLocation"); + gl3wGetBooleani_v = (PFNGLGETBOOLEANI_VPROC) get_proc("glGetBooleani_v"); + gl3wGetBooleanv = (PFNGLGETBOOLEANVPROC) get_proc("glGetBooleanv"); + gl3wGetBufferParameteri64v = (PFNGLGETBUFFERPARAMETERI64VPROC) get_proc("glGetBufferParameteri64v"); + gl3wGetBufferParameteriv = (PFNGLGETBUFFERPARAMETERIVPROC) get_proc("glGetBufferParameteriv"); + gl3wGetBufferPointerv = (PFNGLGETBUFFERPOINTERVPROC) get_proc("glGetBufferPointerv"); + gl3wGetBufferSubData = (PFNGLGETBUFFERSUBDATAPROC) get_proc("glGetBufferSubData"); + gl3wGetCompressedTexImage = (PFNGLGETCOMPRESSEDTEXIMAGEPROC) get_proc("glGetCompressedTexImage"); + gl3wGetCompressedTextureImage = (PFNGLGETCOMPRESSEDTEXTUREIMAGEPROC) get_proc("glGetCompressedTextureImage"); + gl3wGetCompressedTextureSubImage = (PFNGLGETCOMPRESSEDTEXTURESUBIMAGEPROC) get_proc("glGetCompressedTextureSubImage"); + gl3wGetDebugMessageLog = (PFNGLGETDEBUGMESSAGELOGPROC) get_proc("glGetDebugMessageLog"); + gl3wGetDebugMessageLogARB = (PFNGLGETDEBUGMESSAGELOGARBPROC) get_proc("glGetDebugMessageLogARB"); + gl3wGetDoublei_v = (PFNGLGETDOUBLEI_VPROC) get_proc("glGetDoublei_v"); + gl3wGetDoublev = (PFNGLGETDOUBLEVPROC) get_proc("glGetDoublev"); + gl3wGetError = (PFNGLGETERRORPROC) get_proc("glGetError"); + gl3wGetFloati_v = (PFNGLGETFLOATI_VPROC) get_proc("glGetFloati_v"); + gl3wGetFloatv = (PFNGLGETFLOATVPROC) get_proc("glGetFloatv"); + gl3wGetFragDataIndex = (PFNGLGETFRAGDATAINDEXPROC) get_proc("glGetFragDataIndex"); + gl3wGetFragDataLocation = (PFNGLGETFRAGDATALOCATIONPROC) get_proc("glGetFragDataLocation"); + gl3wGetFramebufferAttachmentParameteriv = (PFNGLGETFRAMEBUFFERATTACHMENTPARAMETERIVPROC) get_proc("glGetFramebufferAttachmentParameteriv"); + gl3wGetFramebufferParameteriv = (PFNGLGETFRAMEBUFFERPARAMETERIVPROC) get_proc("glGetFramebufferParameteriv"); + gl3wGetGraphicsResetStatus = (PFNGLGETGRAPHICSRESETSTATUSPROC) get_proc("glGetGraphicsResetStatus"); + gl3wGetGraphicsResetStatusARB = (PFNGLGETGRAPHICSRESETSTATUSARBPROC) get_proc("glGetGraphicsResetStatusARB"); + gl3wGetImageHandleARB = (PFNGLGETIMAGEHANDLEARBPROC) get_proc("glGetImageHandleARB"); + gl3wGetInteger64i_v = (PFNGLGETINTEGER64I_VPROC) get_proc("glGetInteger64i_v"); + gl3wGetInteger64v = (PFNGLGETINTEGER64VPROC) get_proc("glGetInteger64v"); + gl3wGetIntegeri_v = (PFNGLGETINTEGERI_VPROC) get_proc("glGetIntegeri_v"); + gl3wGetIntegerv = (PFNGLGETINTEGERVPROC) get_proc("glGetIntegerv"); + gl3wGetInternalformati64v = (PFNGLGETINTERNALFORMATI64VPROC) get_proc("glGetInternalformati64v"); + gl3wGetInternalformativ = (PFNGLGETINTERNALFORMATIVPROC) get_proc("glGetInternalformativ"); + gl3wGetMultisamplefv = (PFNGLGETMULTISAMPLEFVPROC) get_proc("glGetMultisamplefv"); + gl3wGetNamedBufferParameteri64v = (PFNGLGETNAMEDBUFFERPARAMETERI64VPROC) get_proc("glGetNamedBufferParameteri64v"); + gl3wGetNamedBufferParameteriv = (PFNGLGETNAMEDBUFFERPARAMETERIVPROC) get_proc("glGetNamedBufferParameteriv"); + gl3wGetNamedBufferPointerv = (PFNGLGETNAMEDBUFFERPOINTERVPROC) get_proc("glGetNamedBufferPointerv"); + gl3wGetNamedBufferSubData = (PFNGLGETNAMEDBUFFERSUBDATAPROC) get_proc("glGetNamedBufferSubData"); + gl3wGetNamedFramebufferAttachmentParameteriv = (PFNGLGETNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERATTACHMENTPARAMETERIVPROC) get_proc("glGetNamedFramebufferAttachmentParameteriv"); + gl3wGetNamedFramebufferParameteriv = (PFNGLGETNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERPARAMETERIVPROC) get_proc("glGetNamedFramebufferParameteriv"); + gl3wGetNamedRenderbufferParameteriv = (PFNGLGETNAMEDRENDERBUFFERPARAMETERIVPROC) get_proc("glGetNamedRenderbufferParameteriv"); + gl3wGetNamedStringARB = (PFNGLGETNAMEDSTRINGARBPROC) get_proc("glGetNamedStringARB"); + gl3wGetNamedStringivARB = (PFNGLGETNAMEDSTRINGIVARBPROC) get_proc("glGetNamedStringivARB"); + gl3wGetObjectLabel = (PFNGLGETOBJECTLABELPROC) get_proc("glGetObjectLabel"); + gl3wGetObjectPtrLabel = (PFNGLGETOBJECTPTRLABELPROC) get_proc("glGetObjectPtrLabel"); + gl3wGetPointerv = (PFNGLGETPOINTERVPROC) get_proc("glGetPointerv"); + gl3wGetProgramBinary = (PFNGLGETPROGRAMBINARYPROC) get_proc("glGetProgramBinary"); + gl3wGetProgramInfoLog = (PFNGLGETPROGRAMINFOLOGPROC) get_proc("glGetProgramInfoLog"); + gl3wGetProgramInterfaceiv = (PFNGLGETPROGRAMINTERFACEIVPROC) get_proc("glGetProgramInterfaceiv"); + gl3wGetProgramPipelineInfoLog = (PFNGLGETPROGRAMPIPELINEINFOLOGPROC) get_proc("glGetProgramPipelineInfoLog"); + gl3wGetProgramPipelineiv = (PFNGLGETPROGRAMPIPELINEIVPROC) get_proc("glGetProgramPipelineiv"); + gl3wGetProgramResourceIndex = (PFNGLGETPROGRAMRESOURCEINDEXPROC) get_proc("glGetProgramResourceIndex"); + gl3wGetProgramResourceLocation = (PFNGLGETPROGRAMRESOURCELOCATIONPROC) get_proc("glGetProgramResourceLocation"); + gl3wGetProgramResourceLocationIndex = (PFNGLGETPROGRAMRESOURCELOCATIONINDEXPROC) get_proc("glGetProgramResourceLocationIndex"); + gl3wGetProgramResourceName = (PFNGLGETPROGRAMRESOURCENAMEPROC) get_proc("glGetProgramResourceName"); + gl3wGetProgramResourceiv = (PFNGLGETPROGRAMRESOURCEIVPROC) get_proc("glGetProgramResourceiv"); + gl3wGetProgramStageiv = (PFNGLGETPROGRAMSTAGEIVPROC) get_proc("glGetProgramStageiv"); + gl3wGetProgramiv = (PFNGLGETPROGRAMIVPROC) get_proc("glGetProgramiv"); + gl3wGetQueryBufferObjecti64v = (PFNGLGETQUERYBUFFEROBJECTI64VPROC) get_proc("glGetQueryBufferObjecti64v"); + gl3wGetQueryBufferObjectiv = (PFNGLGETQUERYBUFFEROBJECTIVPROC) get_proc("glGetQueryBufferObjectiv"); + gl3wGetQueryBufferObjectui64v = (PFNGLGETQUERYBUFFEROBJECTUI64VPROC) get_proc("glGetQueryBufferObjectui64v"); + gl3wGetQueryBufferObjectuiv = (PFNGLGETQUERYBUFFEROBJECTUIVPROC) get_proc("glGetQueryBufferObjectuiv"); + gl3wGetQueryIndexediv = (PFNGLGETQUERYINDEXEDIVPROC) get_proc("glGetQueryIndexediv"); + gl3wGetQueryObjecti64v = (PFNGLGETQUERYOBJECTI64VPROC) get_proc("glGetQueryObjecti64v"); + gl3wGetQueryObjectiv = (PFNGLGETQUERYOBJECTIVPROC) get_proc("glGetQueryObjectiv"); + gl3wGetQueryObjectui64v = (PFNGLGETQUERYOBJECTUI64VPROC) get_proc("glGetQueryObjectui64v"); + gl3wGetQueryObjectuiv = (PFNGLGETQUERYOBJECTUIVPROC) get_proc("glGetQueryObjectuiv"); + gl3wGetQueryiv = (PFNGLGETQUERYIVPROC) get_proc("glGetQueryiv"); + gl3wGetRenderbufferParameteriv = (PFNGLGETRENDERBUFFERPARAMETERIVPROC) get_proc("glGetRenderbufferParameteriv"); + gl3wGetSamplerParameterIiv = (PFNGLGETSAMPLERPARAMETERIIVPROC) get_proc("glGetSamplerParameterIiv"); + gl3wGetSamplerParameterIuiv = (PFNGLGETSAMPLERPARAMETERIUIVPROC) get_proc("glGetSamplerParameterIuiv"); + gl3wGetSamplerParameterfv = (PFNGLGETSAMPLERPARAMETERFVPROC) get_proc("glGetSamplerParameterfv"); + gl3wGetSamplerParameteriv = (PFNGLGETSAMPLERPARAMETERIVPROC) get_proc("glGetSamplerParameteriv"); + gl3wGetShaderInfoLog = (PFNGLGETSHADERINFOLOGPROC) get_proc("glGetShaderInfoLog"); + gl3wGetShaderPrecisionFormat = (PFNGLGETSHADERPRECISIONFORMATPROC) get_proc("glGetShaderPrecisionFormat"); + gl3wGetShaderSource = (PFNGLGETSHADERSOURCEPROC) get_proc("glGetShaderSource"); + gl3wGetShaderiv = (PFNGLGETSHADERIVPROC) get_proc("glGetShaderiv"); + gl3wGetString = (PFNGLGETSTRINGPROC) get_proc("glGetString"); + gl3wGetStringi = (PFNGLGETSTRINGIPROC) get_proc("glGetStringi"); + gl3wGetSubroutineIndex = (PFNGLGETSUBROUTINEINDEXPROC) get_proc("glGetSubroutineIndex"); + gl3wGetSubroutineUniformLocation = (PFNGLGETSUBROUTINEUNIFORMLOCATIONPROC) get_proc("glGetSubroutineUniformLocation"); + gl3wGetSynciv = (PFNGLGETSYNCIVPROC) get_proc("glGetSynciv"); + gl3wGetTexImage = (PFNGLGETTEXIMAGEPROC) get_proc("glGetTexImage"); + gl3wGetTexLevelParameterfv = (PFNGLGETTEXLEVELPARAMETERFVPROC) get_proc("glGetTexLevelParameterfv"); + gl3wGetTexLevelParameteriv = (PFNGLGETTEXLEVELPARAMETERIVPROC) get_proc("glGetTexLevelParameteriv"); + gl3wGetTexParameterIiv = (PFNGLGETTEXPARAMETERIIVPROC) get_proc("glGetTexParameterIiv"); + gl3wGetTexParameterIuiv = (PFNGLGETTEXPARAMETERIUIVPROC) get_proc("glGetTexParameterIuiv"); + gl3wGetTexParameterfv = (PFNGLGETTEXPARAMETERFVPROC) get_proc("glGetTexParameterfv"); + gl3wGetTexParameteriv = (PFNGLGETTEXPARAMETERIVPROC) get_proc("glGetTexParameteriv"); + gl3wGetTextureHandleARB = (PFNGLGETTEXTUREHANDLEARBPROC) get_proc("glGetTextureHandleARB"); + gl3wGetTextureImage = (PFNGLGETTEXTUREIMAGEPROC) get_proc("glGetTextureImage"); + gl3wGetTextureLevelParameterfv = (PFNGLGETTEXTURELEVELPARAMETERFVPROC) get_proc("glGetTextureLevelParameterfv"); + gl3wGetTextureLevelParameteriv = (PFNGLGETTEXTURELEVELPARAMETERIVPROC) get_proc("glGetTextureLevelParameteriv"); + gl3wGetTextureParameterIiv = (PFNGLGETTEXTUREPARAMETERIIVPROC) get_proc("glGetTextureParameterIiv"); + gl3wGetTextureParameterIuiv = (PFNGLGETTEXTUREPARAMETERIUIVPROC) get_proc("glGetTextureParameterIuiv"); + gl3wGetTextureParameterfv = (PFNGLGETTEXTUREPARAMETERFVPROC) get_proc("glGetTextureParameterfv"); + gl3wGetTextureParameteriv = (PFNGLGETTEXTUREPARAMETERIVPROC) get_proc("glGetTextureParameteriv"); + gl3wGetTextureSamplerHandleARB = (PFNGLGETTEXTURESAMPLERHANDLEARBPROC) get_proc("glGetTextureSamplerHandleARB"); + gl3wGetTextureSubImage = (PFNGLGETTEXTURESUBIMAGEPROC) get_proc("glGetTextureSubImage"); + gl3wGetTransformFeedbackVarying = (PFNGLGETTRANSFORMFEEDBACKVARYINGPROC) get_proc("glGetTransformFeedbackVarying"); + gl3wGetTransformFeedbacki64_v = (PFNGLGETTRANSFORMFEEDBACKI64_VPROC) get_proc("glGetTransformFeedbacki64_v"); + gl3wGetTransformFeedbacki_v = (PFNGLGETTRANSFORMFEEDBACKI_VPROC) get_proc("glGetTransformFeedbacki_v"); + gl3wGetTransformFeedbackiv = (PFNGLGETTRANSFORMFEEDBACKIVPROC) get_proc("glGetTransformFeedbackiv"); + gl3wGetUniformBlockIndex = (PFNGLGETUNIFORMBLOCKINDEXPROC) get_proc("glGetUniformBlockIndex"); + gl3wGetUniformIndices = (PFNGLGETUNIFORMINDICESPROC) get_proc("glGetUniformIndices"); + gl3wGetUniformLocation = (PFNGLGETUNIFORMLOCATIONPROC) get_proc("glGetUniformLocation"); + gl3wGetUniformSubroutineuiv = (PFNGLGETUNIFORMSUBROUTINEUIVPROC) get_proc("glGetUniformSubroutineuiv"); + gl3wGetUniformdv = (PFNGLGETUNIFORMDVPROC) get_proc("glGetUniformdv"); + gl3wGetUniformfv = (PFNGLGETUNIFORMFVPROC) get_proc("glGetUniformfv"); + gl3wGetUniformiv = (PFNGLGETUNIFORMIVPROC) get_proc("glGetUniformiv"); + gl3wGetUniformuiv = (PFNGLGETUNIFORMUIVPROC) get_proc("glGetUniformuiv"); + gl3wGetVertexArrayIndexed64iv = (PFNGLGETVERTEXARRAYINDEXED64IVPROC) get_proc("glGetVertexArrayIndexed64iv"); + gl3wGetVertexArrayIndexediv = (PFNGLGETVERTEXARRAYINDEXEDIVPROC) get_proc("glGetVertexArrayIndexediv"); + gl3wGetVertexArrayiv = (PFNGLGETVERTEXARRAYIVPROC) get_proc("glGetVertexArrayiv"); + gl3wGetVertexAttribIiv = (PFNGLGETVERTEXATTRIBIIVPROC) get_proc("glGetVertexAttribIiv"); + gl3wGetVertexAttribIuiv = (PFNGLGETVERTEXATTRIBIUIVPROC) get_proc("glGetVertexAttribIuiv"); + gl3wGetVertexAttribLdv = (PFNGLGETVERTEXATTRIBLDVPROC) get_proc("glGetVertexAttribLdv"); + gl3wGetVertexAttribLui64vARB = (PFNGLGETVERTEXATTRIBLUI64VARBPROC) get_proc("glGetVertexAttribLui64vARB"); + gl3wGetVertexAttribPointerv = (PFNGLGETVERTEXATTRIBPOINTERVPROC) get_proc("glGetVertexAttribPointerv"); + gl3wGetVertexAttribdv = (PFNGLGETVERTEXATTRIBDVPROC) get_proc("glGetVertexAttribdv"); + gl3wGetVertexAttribfv = (PFNGLGETVERTEXATTRIBFVPROC) get_proc("glGetVertexAttribfv"); + gl3wGetVertexAttribiv = (PFNGLGETVERTEXATTRIBIVPROC) get_proc("glGetVertexAttribiv"); + gl3wGetnCompressedTexImage = (PFNGLGETNCOMPRESSEDTEXIMAGEPROC) get_proc("glGetnCompressedTexImage"); + gl3wGetnCompressedTexImageARB = (PFNGLGETNCOMPRESSEDTEXIMAGEARBPROC) get_proc("glGetnCompressedTexImageARB"); + gl3wGetnTexImage = (PFNGLGETNTEXIMAGEPROC) get_proc("glGetnTexImage"); + gl3wGetnTexImageARB = (PFNGLGETNTEXIMAGEARBPROC) get_proc("glGetnTexImageARB"); + gl3wGetnUniformdv = (PFNGLGETNUNIFORMDVPROC) get_proc("glGetnUniformdv"); + gl3wGetnUniformdvARB = (PFNGLGETNUNIFORMDVARBPROC) get_proc("glGetnUniformdvARB"); + gl3wGetnUniformfv = (PFNGLGETNUNIFORMFVPROC) get_proc("glGetnUniformfv"); + gl3wGetnUniformfvARB = (PFNGLGETNUNIFORMFVARBPROC) get_proc("glGetnUniformfvARB"); + gl3wGetnUniformiv = (PFNGLGETNUNIFORMIVPROC) get_proc("glGetnUniformiv"); + gl3wGetnUniformivARB = (PFNGLGETNUNIFORMIVARBPROC) get_proc("glGetnUniformivARB"); + gl3wGetnUniformuiv = (PFNGLGETNUNIFORMUIVPROC) get_proc("glGetnUniformuiv"); + gl3wGetnUniformuivARB = (PFNGLGETNUNIFORMUIVARBPROC) get_proc("glGetnUniformuivARB"); + gl3wHint = (PFNGLHINTPROC) get_proc("glHint"); + gl3wInvalidateBufferData = (PFNGLINVALIDATEBUFFERDATAPROC) get_proc("glInvalidateBufferData"); + gl3wInvalidateBufferSubData = (PFNGLINVALIDATEBUFFERSUBDATAPROC) get_proc("glInvalidateBufferSubData"); + gl3wInvalidateFramebuffer = (PFNGLINVALIDATEFRAMEBUFFERPROC) get_proc("glInvalidateFramebuffer"); + gl3wInvalidateNamedFramebufferData = (PFNGLINVALIDATENAMEDFRAMEBUFFERDATAPROC) get_proc("glInvalidateNamedFramebufferData"); + gl3wInvalidateNamedFramebufferSubData = (PFNGLINVALIDATENAMEDFRAMEBUFFERSUBDATAPROC) get_proc("glInvalidateNamedFramebufferSubData"); + gl3wInvalidateSubFramebuffer = (PFNGLINVALIDATESUBFRAMEBUFFERPROC) get_proc("glInvalidateSubFramebuffer"); + gl3wInvalidateTexImage = (PFNGLINVALIDATETEXIMAGEPROC) get_proc("glInvalidateTexImage"); + gl3wInvalidateTexSubImage = (PFNGLINVALIDATETEXSUBIMAGEPROC) get_proc("glInvalidateTexSubImage"); + gl3wIsBuffer = (PFNGLISBUFFERPROC) get_proc("glIsBuffer"); + gl3wIsEnabled = (PFNGLISENABLEDPROC) get_proc("glIsEnabled"); + gl3wIsEnabledi = (PFNGLISENABLEDIPROC) get_proc("glIsEnabledi"); + gl3wIsFramebuffer = (PFNGLISFRAMEBUFFERPROC) get_proc("glIsFramebuffer"); + gl3wIsImageHandleResidentARB = (PFNGLISIMAGEHANDLERESIDENTARBPROC) get_proc("glIsImageHandleResidentARB"); + gl3wIsNamedStringARB = (PFNGLISNAMEDSTRINGARBPROC) get_proc("glIsNamedStringARB"); + gl3wIsProgram = (PFNGLISPROGRAMPROC) get_proc("glIsProgram"); + gl3wIsProgramPipeline = (PFNGLISPROGRAMPIPELINEPROC) get_proc("glIsProgramPipeline"); + gl3wIsQuery = (PFNGLISQUERYPROC) get_proc("glIsQuery"); + gl3wIsRenderbuffer = (PFNGLISRENDERBUFFERPROC) get_proc("glIsRenderbuffer"); + gl3wIsSampler = (PFNGLISSAMPLERPROC) get_proc("glIsSampler"); + gl3wIsShader = (PFNGLISSHADERPROC) get_proc("glIsShader"); + gl3wIsSync = (PFNGLISSYNCPROC) get_proc("glIsSync"); + gl3wIsTexture = (PFNGLISTEXTUREPROC) get_proc("glIsTexture"); + gl3wIsTextureHandleResidentARB = (PFNGLISTEXTUREHANDLERESIDENTARBPROC) get_proc("glIsTextureHandleResidentARB"); + gl3wIsTransformFeedback = (PFNGLISTRANSFORMFEEDBACKPROC) get_proc("glIsTransformFeedback"); + gl3wIsVertexArray = (PFNGLISVERTEXARRAYPROC) get_proc("glIsVertexArray"); + gl3wLineWidth = (PFNGLLINEWIDTHPROC) get_proc("glLineWidth"); + gl3wLinkProgram = (PFNGLLINKPROGRAMPROC) get_proc("glLinkProgram"); + gl3wLogicOp = (PFNGLLOGICOPPROC) get_proc("glLogicOp"); + gl3wMakeImageHandleNonResidentARB = (PFNGLMAKEIMAGEHANDLENONRESIDENTARBPROC) get_proc("glMakeImageHandleNonResidentARB"); + gl3wMakeImageHandleResidentARB = (PFNGLMAKEIMAGEHANDLERESIDENTARBPROC) get_proc("glMakeImageHandleResidentARB"); + gl3wMakeTextureHandleNonResidentARB = (PFNGLMAKETEXTUREHANDLENONRESIDENTARBPROC) get_proc("glMakeTextureHandleNonResidentARB"); + gl3wMakeTextureHandleResidentARB = (PFNGLMAKETEXTUREHANDLERESIDENTARBPROC) get_proc("glMakeTextureHandleResidentARB"); + gl3wMapBuffer = (PFNGLMAPBUFFERPROC) get_proc("glMapBuffer"); + gl3wMapBufferRange = (PFNGLMAPBUFFERRANGEPROC) get_proc("glMapBufferRange"); + gl3wMapNamedBuffer = (PFNGLMAPNAMEDBUFFERPROC) get_proc("glMapNamedBuffer"); + gl3wMapNamedBufferRange = (PFNGLMAPNAMEDBUFFERRANGEPROC) get_proc("glMapNamedBufferRange"); + gl3wMemoryBarrier = (PFNGLMEMORYBARRIERPROC) get_proc("glMemoryBarrier"); + gl3wMemoryBarrierByRegion = (PFNGLMEMORYBARRIERBYREGIONPROC) get_proc("glMemoryBarrierByRegion"); + gl3wMinSampleShading = (PFNGLMINSAMPLESHADINGPROC) get_proc("glMinSampleShading"); + gl3wMinSampleShadingARB = (PFNGLMINSAMPLESHADINGARBPROC) get_proc("glMinSampleShadingARB"); + gl3wMultiDrawArrays = (PFNGLMULTIDRAWARRAYSPROC) get_proc("glMultiDrawArrays"); + gl3wMultiDrawArraysIndirect = (PFNGLMULTIDRAWARRAYSINDIRECTPROC) get_proc("glMultiDrawArraysIndirect"); + gl3wMultiDrawArraysIndirectCountARB = (PFNGLMULTIDRAWARRAYSINDIRECTCOUNTARBPROC) get_proc("glMultiDrawArraysIndirectCountARB"); + gl3wMultiDrawElements = (PFNGLMULTIDRAWELEMENTSPROC) get_proc("glMultiDrawElements"); + gl3wMultiDrawElementsBaseVertex = (PFNGLMULTIDRAWELEMENTSBASEVERTEXPROC) get_proc("glMultiDrawElementsBaseVertex"); + gl3wMultiDrawElementsIndirect = (PFNGLMULTIDRAWELEMENTSINDIRECTPROC) get_proc("glMultiDrawElementsIndirect"); + gl3wMultiDrawElementsIndirectCountARB = (PFNGLMULTIDRAWELEMENTSINDIRECTCOUNTARBPROC) get_proc("glMultiDrawElementsIndirectCountARB"); + gl3wNamedBufferData = (PFNGLNAMEDBUFFERDATAPROC) get_proc("glNamedBufferData"); + gl3wNamedBufferPageCommitmentARB = (PFNGLNAMEDBUFFERPAGECOMMITMENTARBPROC) get_proc("glNamedBufferPageCommitmentARB"); + gl3wNamedBufferPageCommitmentEXT = (PFNGLNAMEDBUFFERPAGECOMMITMENTEXTPROC) get_proc("glNamedBufferPageCommitmentEXT"); + gl3wNamedBufferStorage = (PFNGLNAMEDBUFFERSTORAGEPROC) get_proc("glNamedBufferStorage"); + gl3wNamedBufferSubData = (PFNGLNAMEDBUFFERSUBDATAPROC) get_proc("glNamedBufferSubData"); + gl3wNamedFramebufferDrawBuffer = (PFNGLNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERDRAWBUFFERPROC) get_proc("glNamedFramebufferDrawBuffer"); + gl3wNamedFramebufferDrawBuffers = (PFNGLNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERDRAWBUFFERSPROC) get_proc("glNamedFramebufferDrawBuffers"); + gl3wNamedFramebufferParameteri = (PFNGLNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERPARAMETERIPROC) get_proc("glNamedFramebufferParameteri"); + gl3wNamedFramebufferReadBuffer = (PFNGLNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERREADBUFFERPROC) get_proc("glNamedFramebufferReadBuffer"); + gl3wNamedFramebufferRenderbuffer = (PFNGLNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERRENDERBUFFERPROC) get_proc("glNamedFramebufferRenderbuffer"); + gl3wNamedFramebufferTexture = (PFNGLNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERTEXTUREPROC) get_proc("glNamedFramebufferTexture"); + gl3wNamedFramebufferTextureLayer = (PFNGLNAMEDFRAMEBUFFERTEXTURELAYERPROC) get_proc("glNamedFramebufferTextureLayer"); + gl3wNamedRenderbufferStorage = (PFNGLNAMEDRENDERBUFFERSTORAGEPROC) get_proc("glNamedRenderbufferStorage"); + gl3wNamedRenderbufferStorageMultisample = (PFNGLNAMEDRENDERBUFFERSTORAGEMULTISAMPLEPROC) get_proc("glNamedRenderbufferStorageMultisample"); + gl3wNamedStringARB = (PFNGLNAMEDSTRINGARBPROC) get_proc("glNamedStringARB"); + gl3wObjectLabel = (PFNGLOBJECTLABELPROC) get_proc("glObjectLabel"); + gl3wObjectPtrLabel = (PFNGLOBJECTPTRLABELPROC) get_proc("glObjectPtrLabel"); + gl3wPatchParameterfv = (PFNGLPATCHPARAMETERFVPROC) get_proc("glPatchParameterfv"); + gl3wPatchParameteri = (PFNGLPATCHPARAMETERIPROC) get_proc("glPatchParameteri"); + gl3wPauseTransformFeedback = (PFNGLPAUSETRANSFORMFEEDBACKPROC) get_proc("glPauseTransformFeedback"); + gl3wPixelStoref = (PFNGLPIXELSTOREFPROC) get_proc("glPixelStoref"); + gl3wPixelStorei = (PFNGLPIXELSTOREIPROC) get_proc("glPixelStorei"); + gl3wPointParameterf = (PFNGLPOINTPARAMETERFPROC) get_proc("glPointParameterf"); + gl3wPointParameterfv = (PFNGLPOINTPARAMETERFVPROC) get_proc("glPointParameterfv"); + gl3wPointParameteri = (PFNGLPOINTPARAMETERIPROC) get_proc("glPointParameteri"); + gl3wPointParameteriv = (PFNGLPOINTPARAMETERIVPROC) get_proc("glPointParameteriv"); + gl3wPointSize = (PFNGLPOINTSIZEPROC) get_proc("glPointSize"); + gl3wPolygonMode = (PFNGLPOLYGONMODEPROC) get_proc("glPolygonMode"); + gl3wPolygonOffset = (PFNGLPOLYGONOFFSETPROC) get_proc("glPolygonOffset"); + gl3wPopDebugGroup = (PFNGLPOPDEBUGGROUPPROC) get_proc("glPopDebugGroup"); + gl3wPrimitiveRestartIndex = (PFNGLPRIMITIVERESTARTINDEXPROC) get_proc("glPrimitiveRestartIndex"); + gl3wProgramBinary = (PFNGLPROGRAMBINARYPROC) get_proc("glProgramBinary"); + gl3wProgramParameteri = (PFNGLPROGRAMPARAMETERIPROC) get_proc("glProgramParameteri"); + gl3wProgramUniform1d = (PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM1DPROC) get_proc("glProgramUniform1d"); + gl3wProgramUniform1dv = (PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM1DVPROC) get_proc("glProgramUniform1dv"); + gl3wProgramUniform1f = (PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM1FPROC) get_proc("glProgramUniform1f"); + gl3wProgramUniform1fv = (PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM1FVPROC) get_proc("glProgramUniform1fv"); + gl3wProgramUniform1i = (PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM1IPROC) get_proc("glProgramUniform1i"); + gl3wProgramUniform1iv = (PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM1IVPROC) get_proc("glProgramUniform1iv"); + gl3wProgramUniform1ui = (PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM1UIPROC) get_proc("glProgramUniform1ui"); + gl3wProgramUniform1uiv = (PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM1UIVPROC) get_proc("glProgramUniform1uiv"); + gl3wProgramUniform2d = (PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM2DPROC) get_proc("glProgramUniform2d"); + gl3wProgramUniform2dv = (PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM2DVPROC) get_proc("glProgramUniform2dv"); + gl3wProgramUniform2f = (PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM2FPROC) get_proc("glProgramUniform2f"); + gl3wProgramUniform2fv = (PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM2FVPROC) get_proc("glProgramUniform2fv"); + gl3wProgramUniform2i = (PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM2IPROC) get_proc("glProgramUniform2i"); + gl3wProgramUniform2iv = (PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM2IVPROC) get_proc("glProgramUniform2iv"); + gl3wProgramUniform2ui = (PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM2UIPROC) get_proc("glProgramUniform2ui"); + gl3wProgramUniform2uiv = (PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM2UIVPROC) get_proc("glProgramUniform2uiv"); + gl3wProgramUniform3d = (PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM3DPROC) get_proc("glProgramUniform3d"); + gl3wProgramUniform3dv = (PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM3DVPROC) get_proc("glProgramUniform3dv"); + gl3wProgramUniform3f = (PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM3FPROC) get_proc("glProgramUniform3f"); + gl3wProgramUniform3fv = (PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM3FVPROC) get_proc("glProgramUniform3fv"); + gl3wProgramUniform3i = (PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM3IPROC) get_proc("glProgramUniform3i"); + gl3wProgramUniform3iv = (PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM3IVPROC) get_proc("glProgramUniform3iv"); + gl3wProgramUniform3ui = (PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM3UIPROC) get_proc("glProgramUniform3ui"); + gl3wProgramUniform3uiv = (PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM3UIVPROC) get_proc("glProgramUniform3uiv"); + gl3wProgramUniform4d = (PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM4DPROC) get_proc("glProgramUniform4d"); + gl3wProgramUniform4dv = (PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM4DVPROC) get_proc("glProgramUniform4dv"); + gl3wProgramUniform4f = (PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM4FPROC) get_proc("glProgramUniform4f"); + gl3wProgramUniform4fv = (PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM4FVPROC) get_proc("glProgramUniform4fv"); + gl3wProgramUniform4i = (PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM4IPROC) get_proc("glProgramUniform4i"); + gl3wProgramUniform4iv = (PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM4IVPROC) get_proc("glProgramUniform4iv"); + gl3wProgramUniform4ui = (PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM4UIPROC) get_proc("glProgramUniform4ui"); + gl3wProgramUniform4uiv = (PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORM4UIVPROC) get_proc("glProgramUniform4uiv"); + gl3wProgramUniformHandleui64ARB = (PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMHANDLEUI64ARBPROC) get_proc("glProgramUniformHandleui64ARB"); + gl3wProgramUniformHandleui64vARB = (PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMHANDLEUI64VARBPROC) get_proc("glProgramUniformHandleui64vARB"); + gl3wProgramUniformMatrix2dv = (PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX2DVPROC) get_proc("glProgramUniformMatrix2dv"); + gl3wProgramUniformMatrix2fv = (PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX2FVPROC) get_proc("glProgramUniformMatrix2fv"); + gl3wProgramUniformMatrix2x3dv = (PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX2X3DVPROC) get_proc("glProgramUniformMatrix2x3dv"); + gl3wProgramUniformMatrix2x3fv = (PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX2X3FVPROC) get_proc("glProgramUniformMatrix2x3fv"); + gl3wProgramUniformMatrix2x4dv = (PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX2X4DVPROC) get_proc("glProgramUniformMatrix2x4dv"); + gl3wProgramUniformMatrix2x4fv = (PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX2X4FVPROC) get_proc("glProgramUniformMatrix2x4fv"); + gl3wProgramUniformMatrix3dv = (PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX3DVPROC) get_proc("glProgramUniformMatrix3dv"); + gl3wProgramUniformMatrix3fv = (PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX3FVPROC) get_proc("glProgramUniformMatrix3fv"); + gl3wProgramUniformMatrix3x2dv = (PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX3X2DVPROC) get_proc("glProgramUniformMatrix3x2dv"); + gl3wProgramUniformMatrix3x2fv = (PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX3X2FVPROC) get_proc("glProgramUniformMatrix3x2fv"); + gl3wProgramUniformMatrix3x4dv = (PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX3X4DVPROC) get_proc("glProgramUniformMatrix3x4dv"); + gl3wProgramUniformMatrix3x4fv = (PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX3X4FVPROC) get_proc("glProgramUniformMatrix3x4fv"); + gl3wProgramUniformMatrix4dv = (PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX4DVPROC) get_proc("glProgramUniformMatrix4dv"); + gl3wProgramUniformMatrix4fv = (PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX4FVPROC) get_proc("glProgramUniformMatrix4fv"); + gl3wProgramUniformMatrix4x2dv = (PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX4X2DVPROC) get_proc("glProgramUniformMatrix4x2dv"); + gl3wProgramUniformMatrix4x2fv = (PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX4X2FVPROC) get_proc("glProgramUniformMatrix4x2fv"); + gl3wProgramUniformMatrix4x3dv = (PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX4X3DVPROC) get_proc("glProgramUniformMatrix4x3dv"); + gl3wProgramUniformMatrix4x3fv = (PFNGLPROGRAMUNIFORMMATRIX4X3FVPROC) get_proc("glProgramUniformMatrix4x3fv"); + gl3wProvokingVertex = (PFNGLPROVOKINGVERTEXPROC) get_proc("glProvokingVertex"); + gl3wPushDebugGroup = (PFNGLPUSHDEBUGGROUPPROC) get_proc("glPushDebugGroup"); + gl3wQueryCounter = (PFNGLQUERYCOUNTERPROC) get_proc("glQueryCounter"); + gl3wReadBuffer = (PFNGLREADBUFFERPROC) get_proc("glReadBuffer"); + gl3wReadPixels = (PFNGLREADPIXELSPROC) get_proc("glReadPixels"); + gl3wReadnPixels = (PFNGLREADNPIXELSPROC) get_proc("glReadnPixels"); + gl3wReadnPixelsARB = (PFNGLREADNPIXELSARBPROC) get_proc("glReadnPixelsARB"); + gl3wReleaseShaderCompiler = (PFNGLRELEASESHADERCOMPILERPROC) get_proc("glReleaseShaderCompiler"); + gl3wRenderbufferStorage = (PFNGLRENDERBUFFERSTORAGEPROC) get_proc("glRenderbufferStorage"); + gl3wRenderbufferStorageMultisample = (PFNGLRENDERBUFFERSTORAGEMULTISAMPLEPROC) get_proc("glRenderbufferStorageMultisample"); + gl3wResumeTransformFeedback = (PFNGLRESUMETRANSFORMFEEDBACKPROC) get_proc("glResumeTransformFeedback"); + gl3wSampleCoverage = (PFNGLSAMPLECOVERAGEPROC) get_proc("glSampleCoverage"); + gl3wSampleMaski = (PFNGLSAMPLEMASKIPROC) get_proc("glSampleMaski"); + gl3wSamplerParameterIiv = (PFNGLSAMPLERPARAMETERIIVPROC) get_proc("glSamplerParameterIiv"); + gl3wSamplerParameterIuiv = (PFNGLSAMPLERPARAMETERIUIVPROC) get_proc("glSamplerParameterIuiv"); + gl3wSamplerParameterf = (PFNGLSAMPLERPARAMETERFPROC) get_proc("glSamplerParameterf"); + gl3wSamplerParameterfv = (PFNGLSAMPLERPARAMETERFVPROC) get_proc("glSamplerParameterfv"); + gl3wSamplerParameteri = (PFNGLSAMPLERPARAMETERIPROC) get_proc("glSamplerParameteri"); + gl3wSamplerParameteriv = (PFNGLSAMPLERPARAMETERIVPROC) get_proc("glSamplerParameteriv"); + gl3wScissor = (PFNGLSCISSORPROC) get_proc("glScissor"); + gl3wScissorArrayv = (PFNGLSCISSORARRAYVPROC) get_proc("glScissorArrayv"); + gl3wScissorIndexed = (PFNGLSCISSORINDEXEDPROC) get_proc("glScissorIndexed"); + gl3wScissorIndexedv = (PFNGLSCISSORINDEXEDVPROC) get_proc("glScissorIndexedv"); + gl3wShaderBinary = (PFNGLSHADERBINARYPROC) get_proc("glShaderBinary"); + gl3wShaderSource = (PFNGLSHADERSOURCEPROC) get_proc("glShaderSource"); + gl3wShaderStorageBlockBinding = (PFNGLSHADERSTORAGEBLOCKBINDINGPROC) get_proc("glShaderStorageBlockBinding"); + gl3wStencilFunc = (PFNGLSTENCILFUNCPROC) get_proc("glStencilFunc"); + gl3wStencilFuncSeparate = (PFNGLSTENCILFUNCSEPARATEPROC) get_proc("glStencilFuncSeparate"); + gl3wStencilMask = (PFNGLSTENCILMASKPROC) get_proc("glStencilMask"); + gl3wStencilMaskSeparate = (PFNGLSTENCILMASKSEPARATEPROC) get_proc("glStencilMaskSeparate"); + gl3wStencilOp = (PFNGLSTENCILOPPROC) get_proc("glStencilOp"); + gl3wStencilOpSeparate = (PFNGLSTENCILOPSEPARATEPROC) get_proc("glStencilOpSeparate"); + gl3wTexBuffer = (PFNGLTEXBUFFERPROC) get_proc("glTexBuffer"); + gl3wTexBufferRange = (PFNGLTEXBUFFERRANGEPROC) get_proc("glTexBufferRange"); + gl3wTexImage1D = (PFNGLTEXIMAGE1DPROC) get_proc("glTexImage1D"); + gl3wTexImage2D = (PFNGLTEXIMAGE2DPROC) get_proc("glTexImage2D"); + gl3wTexImage2DMultisample = (PFNGLTEXIMAGE2DMULTISAMPLEPROC) get_proc("glTexImage2DMultisample"); + gl3wTexImage3D = (PFNGLTEXIMAGE3DPROC) get_proc("glTexImage3D"); + gl3wTexImage3DMultisample = (PFNGLTEXIMAGE3DMULTISAMPLEPROC) get_proc("glTexImage3DMultisample"); + gl3wTexPageCommitmentARB = (PFNGLTEXPAGECOMMITMENTARBPROC) get_proc("glTexPageCommitmentARB"); + gl3wTexParameterIiv = (PFNGLTEXPARAMETERIIVPROC) get_proc("glTexParameterIiv"); + gl3wTexParameterIuiv = (PFNGLTEXPARAMETERIUIVPROC) get_proc("glTexParameterIuiv"); + gl3wTexParameterf = (PFNGLTEXPARAMETERFPROC) get_proc("glTexParameterf"); + gl3wTexParameterfv = (PFNGLTEXPARAMETERFVPROC) get_proc("glTexParameterfv"); + gl3wTexParameteri = (PFNGLTEXPARAMETERIPROC) get_proc("glTexParameteri"); + gl3wTexParameteriv = (PFNGLTEXPARAMETERIVPROC) get_proc("glTexParameteriv"); + gl3wTexStorage1D = (PFNGLTEXSTORAGE1DPROC) get_proc("glTexStorage1D"); + gl3wTexStorage2D = (PFNGLTEXSTORAGE2DPROC) get_proc("glTexStorage2D"); + gl3wTexStorage2DMultisample = (PFNGLTEXSTORAGE2DMULTISAMPLEPROC) get_proc("glTexStorage2DMultisample"); + gl3wTexStorage3D = (PFNGLTEXSTORAGE3DPROC) get_proc("glTexStorage3D"); + gl3wTexStorage3DMultisample = (PFNGLTEXSTORAGE3DMULTISAMPLEPROC) get_proc("glTexStorage3DMultisample"); + gl3wTexSubImage1D = (PFNGLTEXSUBIMAGE1DPROC) get_proc("glTexSubImage1D"); + gl3wTexSubImage2D = (PFNGLTEXSUBIMAGE2DPROC) get_proc("glTexSubImage2D"); + gl3wTexSubImage3D = (PFNGLTEXSUBIMAGE3DPROC) get_proc("glTexSubImage3D"); + gl3wTextureBarrier = (PFNGLTEXTUREBARRIERPROC) get_proc("glTextureBarrier"); + gl3wTextureBuffer = (PFNGLTEXTUREBUFFERPROC) get_proc("glTextureBuffer"); + gl3wTextureBufferRange = (PFNGLTEXTUREBUFFERRANGEPROC) get_proc("glTextureBufferRange"); + gl3wTextureParameterIiv = (PFNGLTEXTUREPARAMETERIIVPROC) get_proc("glTextureParameterIiv"); + gl3wTextureParameterIuiv = (PFNGLTEXTUREPARAMETERIUIVPROC) get_proc("glTextureParameterIuiv"); + gl3wTextureParameterf = (PFNGLTEXTUREPARAMETERFPROC) get_proc("glTextureParameterf"); + gl3wTextureParameterfv = (PFNGLTEXTUREPARAMETERFVPROC) get_proc("glTextureParameterfv"); + gl3wTextureParameteri = (PFNGLTEXTUREPARAMETERIPROC) get_proc("glTextureParameteri"); + gl3wTextureParameteriv = (PFNGLTEXTUREPARAMETERIVPROC) get_proc("glTextureParameteriv"); + gl3wTextureStorage1D = (PFNGLTEXTURESTORAGE1DPROC) get_proc("glTextureStorage1D"); + gl3wTextureStorage2D = (PFNGLTEXTURESTORAGE2DPROC) get_proc("glTextureStorage2D"); + gl3wTextureStorage2DMultisample = (PFNGLTEXTURESTORAGE2DMULTISAMPLEPROC) get_proc("glTextureStorage2DMultisample"); + gl3wTextureStorage3D = (PFNGLTEXTURESTORAGE3DPROC) get_proc("glTextureStorage3D"); + gl3wTextureStorage3DMultisample = (PFNGLTEXTURESTORAGE3DMULTISAMPLEPROC) get_proc("glTextureStorage3DMultisample"); + gl3wTextureSubImage1D = (PFNGLTEXTURESUBIMAGE1DPROC) get_proc("glTextureSubImage1D"); + gl3wTextureSubImage2D = (PFNGLTEXTURESUBIMAGE2DPROC) get_proc("glTextureSubImage2D"); + gl3wTextureSubImage3D = (PFNGLTEXTURESUBIMAGE3DPROC) get_proc("glTextureSubImage3D"); + gl3wTextureView = (PFNGLTEXTUREVIEWPROC) get_proc("glTextureView"); + gl3wTransformFeedbackBufferBase = (PFNGLTRANSFORMFEEDBACKBUFFERBASEPROC) get_proc("glTransformFeedbackBufferBase"); + gl3wTransformFeedbackBufferRange = (PFNGLTRANSFORMFEEDBACKBUFFERRANGEPROC) get_proc("glTransformFeedbackBufferRange"); + gl3wTransformFeedbackVaryings = (PFNGLTRANSFORMFEEDBACKVARYINGSPROC) get_proc("glTransformFeedbackVaryings"); + gl3wUniform1d = (PFNGLUNIFORM1DPROC) get_proc("glUniform1d"); + gl3wUniform1dv = (PFNGLUNIFORM1DVPROC) get_proc("glUniform1dv"); + gl3wUniform1f = (PFNGLUNIFORM1FPROC) get_proc("glUniform1f"); + gl3wUniform1fv = (PFNGLUNIFORM1FVPROC) get_proc("glUniform1fv"); + gl3wUniform1i = (PFNGLUNIFORM1IPROC) get_proc("glUniform1i"); + gl3wUniform1iv = (PFNGLUNIFORM1IVPROC) get_proc("glUniform1iv"); + gl3wUniform1ui = (PFNGLUNIFORM1UIPROC) get_proc("glUniform1ui"); + gl3wUniform1uiv = (PFNGLUNIFORM1UIVPROC) get_proc("glUniform1uiv"); + gl3wUniform2d = (PFNGLUNIFORM2DPROC) get_proc("glUniform2d"); + gl3wUniform2dv = (PFNGLUNIFORM2DVPROC) get_proc("glUniform2dv"); + gl3wUniform2f = (PFNGLUNIFORM2FPROC) get_proc("glUniform2f"); + gl3wUniform2fv = (PFNGLUNIFORM2FVPROC) get_proc("glUniform2fv"); + gl3wUniform2i = (PFNGLUNIFORM2IPROC) get_proc("glUniform2i"); + gl3wUniform2iv = (PFNGLUNIFORM2IVPROC) get_proc("glUniform2iv"); + gl3wUniform2ui = (PFNGLUNIFORM2UIPROC) get_proc("glUniform2ui"); + gl3wUniform2uiv = (PFNGLUNIFORM2UIVPROC) get_proc("glUniform2uiv"); + gl3wUniform3d = (PFNGLUNIFORM3DPROC) get_proc("glUniform3d"); + gl3wUniform3dv = (PFNGLUNIFORM3DVPROC) get_proc("glUniform3dv"); + gl3wUniform3f = (PFNGLUNIFORM3FPROC) get_proc("glUniform3f"); + gl3wUniform3fv = (PFNGLUNIFORM3FVPROC) get_proc("glUniform3fv"); + gl3wUniform3i = (PFNGLUNIFORM3IPROC) get_proc("glUniform3i"); + gl3wUniform3iv = (PFNGLUNIFORM3IVPROC) get_proc("glUniform3iv"); + gl3wUniform3ui = (PFNGLUNIFORM3UIPROC) get_proc("glUniform3ui"); + gl3wUniform3uiv = (PFNGLUNIFORM3UIVPROC) get_proc("glUniform3uiv"); + gl3wUniform4d = (PFNGLUNIFORM4DPROC) get_proc("glUniform4d"); + gl3wUniform4dv = (PFNGLUNIFORM4DVPROC) get_proc("glUniform4dv"); + gl3wUniform4f = (PFNGLUNIFORM4FPROC) get_proc("glUniform4f"); + gl3wUniform4fv = (PFNGLUNIFORM4FVPROC) get_proc("glUniform4fv"); + gl3wUniform4i = (PFNGLUNIFORM4IPROC) get_proc("glUniform4i"); + gl3wUniform4iv = (PFNGLUNIFORM4IVPROC) get_proc("glUniform4iv"); + gl3wUniform4ui = (PFNGLUNIFORM4UIPROC) get_proc("glUniform4ui"); + gl3wUniform4uiv = (PFNGLUNIFORM4UIVPROC) get_proc("glUniform4uiv"); + gl3wUniformBlockBinding = (PFNGLUNIFORMBLOCKBINDINGPROC) get_proc("glUniformBlockBinding"); + gl3wUniformHandleui64ARB = (PFNGLUNIFORMHANDLEUI64ARBPROC) get_proc("glUniformHandleui64ARB"); + gl3wUniformHandleui64vARB = (PFNGLUNIFORMHANDLEUI64VARBPROC) get_proc("glUniformHandleui64vARB"); + gl3wUniformMatrix2dv = (PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX2DVPROC) get_proc("glUniformMatrix2dv"); + gl3wUniformMatrix2fv = (PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX2FVPROC) get_proc("glUniformMatrix2fv"); + gl3wUniformMatrix2x3dv = (PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX2X3DVPROC) get_proc("glUniformMatrix2x3dv"); + gl3wUniformMatrix2x3fv = (PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX2X3FVPROC) get_proc("glUniformMatrix2x3fv"); + gl3wUniformMatrix2x4dv = (PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX2X4DVPROC) get_proc("glUniformMatrix2x4dv"); + gl3wUniformMatrix2x4fv = (PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX2X4FVPROC) get_proc("glUniformMatrix2x4fv"); + gl3wUniformMatrix3dv = (PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX3DVPROC) get_proc("glUniformMatrix3dv"); + gl3wUniformMatrix3fv = (PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX3FVPROC) get_proc("glUniformMatrix3fv"); + gl3wUniformMatrix3x2dv = (PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX3X2DVPROC) get_proc("glUniformMatrix3x2dv"); + gl3wUniformMatrix3x2fv = (PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX3X2FVPROC) get_proc("glUniformMatrix3x2fv"); + gl3wUniformMatrix3x4dv = (PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX3X4DVPROC) get_proc("glUniformMatrix3x4dv"); + gl3wUniformMatrix3x4fv = (PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX3X4FVPROC) get_proc("glUniformMatrix3x4fv"); + gl3wUniformMatrix4dv = (PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX4DVPROC) get_proc("glUniformMatrix4dv"); + gl3wUniformMatrix4fv = (PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX4FVPROC) get_proc("glUniformMatrix4fv"); + gl3wUniformMatrix4x2dv = (PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX4X2DVPROC) get_proc("glUniformMatrix4x2dv"); + gl3wUniformMatrix4x2fv = (PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX4X2FVPROC) get_proc("glUniformMatrix4x2fv"); + gl3wUniformMatrix4x3dv = (PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX4X3DVPROC) get_proc("glUniformMatrix4x3dv"); + gl3wUniformMatrix4x3fv = (PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX4X3FVPROC) get_proc("glUniformMatrix4x3fv"); + gl3wUniformSubroutinesuiv = (PFNGLUNIFORMSUBROUTINESUIVPROC) get_proc("glUniformSubroutinesuiv"); + gl3wUnmapBuffer = (PFNGLUNMAPBUFFERPROC) get_proc("glUnmapBuffer"); + gl3wUnmapNamedBuffer = (PFNGLUNMAPNAMEDBUFFERPROC) get_proc("glUnmapNamedBuffer"); + gl3wUseProgram = (PFNGLUSEPROGRAMPROC) get_proc("glUseProgram"); + gl3wUseProgramStages = (PFNGLUSEPROGRAMSTAGESPROC) get_proc("glUseProgramStages"); + gl3wValidateProgram = (PFNGLVALIDATEPROGRAMPROC) get_proc("glValidateProgram"); + gl3wValidateProgramPipeline = (PFNGLVALIDATEPROGRAMPIPELINEPROC) get_proc("glValidateProgramPipeline"); + gl3wVertexArrayAttribBinding = (PFNGLVERTEXARRAYATTRIBBINDINGPROC) get_proc("glVertexArrayAttribBinding"); + gl3wVertexArrayAttribFormat = (PFNGLVERTEXARRAYATTRIBFORMATPROC) get_proc("glVertexArrayAttribFormat"); + gl3wVertexArrayAttribIFormat = (PFNGLVERTEXARRAYATTRIBIFORMATPROC) get_proc("glVertexArrayAttribIFormat"); + gl3wVertexArrayAttribLFormat = (PFNGLVERTEXARRAYATTRIBLFORMATPROC) get_proc("glVertexArrayAttribLFormat"); + gl3wVertexArrayBindingDivisor = (PFNGLVERTEXARRAYBINDINGDIVISORPROC) get_proc("glVertexArrayBindingDivisor"); + gl3wVertexArrayElementBuffer = (PFNGLVERTEXARRAYELEMENTBUFFERPROC) get_proc("glVertexArrayElementBuffer"); + gl3wVertexArrayVertexBuffer = (PFNGLVERTEXARRAYVERTEXBUFFERPROC) get_proc("glVertexArrayVertexBuffer"); + gl3wVertexArrayVertexBuffers = (PFNGLVERTEXARRAYVERTEXBUFFERSPROC) get_proc("glVertexArrayVertexBuffers"); + gl3wVertexAttrib1d = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB1DPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttrib1d"); + gl3wVertexAttrib1dv = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB1DVPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttrib1dv"); + gl3wVertexAttrib1f = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB1FPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttrib1f"); + gl3wVertexAttrib1fv = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB1FVPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttrib1fv"); + gl3wVertexAttrib1s = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB1SPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttrib1s"); + gl3wVertexAttrib1sv = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB1SVPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttrib1sv"); + gl3wVertexAttrib2d = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB2DPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttrib2d"); + gl3wVertexAttrib2dv = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB2DVPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttrib2dv"); + gl3wVertexAttrib2f = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB2FPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttrib2f"); + gl3wVertexAttrib2fv = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB2FVPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttrib2fv"); + gl3wVertexAttrib2s = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB2SPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttrib2s"); + gl3wVertexAttrib2sv = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB2SVPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttrib2sv"); + gl3wVertexAttrib3d = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB3DPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttrib3d"); + gl3wVertexAttrib3dv = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB3DVPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttrib3dv"); + gl3wVertexAttrib3f = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB3FPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttrib3f"); + gl3wVertexAttrib3fv = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB3FVPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttrib3fv"); + gl3wVertexAttrib3s = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB3SPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttrib3s"); + gl3wVertexAttrib3sv = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB3SVPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttrib3sv"); + gl3wVertexAttrib4Nbv = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4NBVPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttrib4Nbv"); + gl3wVertexAttrib4Niv = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4NIVPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttrib4Niv"); + gl3wVertexAttrib4Nsv = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4NSVPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttrib4Nsv"); + gl3wVertexAttrib4Nub = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4NUBPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttrib4Nub"); + gl3wVertexAttrib4Nubv = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4NUBVPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttrib4Nubv"); + gl3wVertexAttrib4Nuiv = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4NUIVPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttrib4Nuiv"); + gl3wVertexAttrib4Nusv = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4NUSVPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttrib4Nusv"); + gl3wVertexAttrib4bv = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4BVPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttrib4bv"); + gl3wVertexAttrib4d = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4DPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttrib4d"); + gl3wVertexAttrib4dv = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4DVPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttrib4dv"); + gl3wVertexAttrib4f = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4FPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttrib4f"); + gl3wVertexAttrib4fv = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4FVPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttrib4fv"); + gl3wVertexAttrib4iv = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4IVPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttrib4iv"); + gl3wVertexAttrib4s = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4SPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttrib4s"); + gl3wVertexAttrib4sv = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4SVPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttrib4sv"); + gl3wVertexAttrib4ubv = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4UBVPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttrib4ubv"); + gl3wVertexAttrib4uiv = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4UIVPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttrib4uiv"); + gl3wVertexAttrib4usv = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIB4USVPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttrib4usv"); + gl3wVertexAttribBinding = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBBINDINGPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttribBinding"); + gl3wVertexAttribDivisor = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBDIVISORPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttribDivisor"); + gl3wVertexAttribFormat = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBFORMATPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttribFormat"); + gl3wVertexAttribI1i = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI1IPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttribI1i"); + gl3wVertexAttribI1iv = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI1IVPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttribI1iv"); + gl3wVertexAttribI1ui = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI1UIPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttribI1ui"); + gl3wVertexAttribI1uiv = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI1UIVPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttribI1uiv"); + gl3wVertexAttribI2i = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI2IPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttribI2i"); + gl3wVertexAttribI2iv = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI2IVPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttribI2iv"); + gl3wVertexAttribI2ui = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI2UIPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttribI2ui"); + gl3wVertexAttribI2uiv = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI2UIVPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttribI2uiv"); + gl3wVertexAttribI3i = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI3IPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttribI3i"); + gl3wVertexAttribI3iv = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI3IVPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttribI3iv"); + gl3wVertexAttribI3ui = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI3UIPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttribI3ui"); + gl3wVertexAttribI3uiv = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI3UIVPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttribI3uiv"); + gl3wVertexAttribI4bv = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI4BVPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttribI4bv"); + gl3wVertexAttribI4i = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI4IPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttribI4i"); + gl3wVertexAttribI4iv = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI4IVPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttribI4iv"); + gl3wVertexAttribI4sv = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI4SVPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttribI4sv"); + gl3wVertexAttribI4ubv = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI4UBVPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttribI4ubv"); + gl3wVertexAttribI4ui = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI4UIPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttribI4ui"); + gl3wVertexAttribI4uiv = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI4UIVPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttribI4uiv"); + gl3wVertexAttribI4usv = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBI4USVPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttribI4usv"); + gl3wVertexAttribIFormat = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBIFORMATPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttribIFormat"); + gl3wVertexAttribIPointer = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBIPOINTERPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttribIPointer"); + gl3wVertexAttribL1d = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBL1DPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttribL1d"); + gl3wVertexAttribL1dv = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBL1DVPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttribL1dv"); + gl3wVertexAttribL1ui64ARB = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBL1UI64ARBPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttribL1ui64ARB"); + gl3wVertexAttribL1ui64vARB = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBL1UI64VARBPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttribL1ui64vARB"); + gl3wVertexAttribL2d = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBL2DPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttribL2d"); + gl3wVertexAttribL2dv = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBL2DVPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttribL2dv"); + gl3wVertexAttribL3d = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBL3DPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttribL3d"); + gl3wVertexAttribL3dv = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBL3DVPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttribL3dv"); + gl3wVertexAttribL4d = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBL4DPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttribL4d"); + gl3wVertexAttribL4dv = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBL4DVPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttribL4dv"); + gl3wVertexAttribLFormat = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBLFORMATPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttribLFormat"); + gl3wVertexAttribLPointer = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBLPOINTERPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttribLPointer"); + gl3wVertexAttribP1ui = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBP1UIPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttribP1ui"); + gl3wVertexAttribP1uiv = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBP1UIVPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttribP1uiv"); + gl3wVertexAttribP2ui = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBP2UIPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttribP2ui"); + gl3wVertexAttribP2uiv = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBP2UIVPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttribP2uiv"); + gl3wVertexAttribP3ui = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBP3UIPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttribP3ui"); + gl3wVertexAttribP3uiv = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBP3UIVPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttribP3uiv"); + gl3wVertexAttribP4ui = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBP4UIPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttribP4ui"); + gl3wVertexAttribP4uiv = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBP4UIVPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttribP4uiv"); + gl3wVertexAttribPointer = (PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBPOINTERPROC) get_proc("glVertexAttribPointer"); + gl3wVertexBindingDivisor = (PFNGLVERTEXBINDINGDIVISORPROC) get_proc("glVertexBindingDivisor"); + gl3wViewport = (PFNGLVIEWPORTPROC) get_proc("glViewport"); + gl3wViewportArrayv = (PFNGLVIEWPORTARRAYVPROC) get_proc("glViewportArrayv"); + gl3wViewportIndexedf = (PFNGLVIEWPORTINDEXEDFPROC) get_proc("glViewportIndexedf"); + gl3wViewportIndexedfv = (PFNGLVIEWPORTINDEXEDFVPROC) get_proc("glViewportIndexedfv"); + gl3wWaitSync = (PFNGLWAITSYNCPROC) get_proc("glWaitSync"); +} diff --git a/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/imgui-1.84.2/LICENSE.txt b/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/imgui-1.84.2/LICENSE.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000..780533d --- /dev/null +++ b/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/imgui-1.84.2/LICENSE.txt @@ -0,0 +1,21 @@ +The MIT License (MIT) + +Copyright (c) 2014-2021 Omar Cornut + +Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy +of this software and associated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal +in the Software without restriction, including without limitation the rights +to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell +copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is +furnished to do so, subject to the following conditions: + +The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in all +copies or substantial portions of the Software. + +THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR +IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, +FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE +AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER +LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, +OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE +SOFTWARE. diff --git a/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/imgui-1.84.2/imconfig.h b/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/imgui-1.84.2/imconfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000..a0c86ca --- /dev/null +++ b/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/imgui-1.84.2/imconfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,123 @@ +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// COMPILE-TIME OPTIONS FOR DEAR IMGUI +// Runtime options (clipboard callbacks, enabling various features, etc.) can generally be set via the ImGuiIO structure. +// You can use ImGui::SetAllocatorFunctions() before calling ImGui::CreateContext() to rewire memory allocation functions. +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// A) You may edit imconfig.h (and not overwrite it when updating Dear ImGui, or maintain a patch/rebased branch with your modifications to it) +// B) or '#define IMGUI_USER_CONFIG "my_imgui_config.h"' in your project and then add directives in your own file without touching this template. +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// You need to make sure that configuration settings are defined consistently _everywhere_ Dear ImGui is used, which include the imgui*.cpp +// files but also _any_ of your code that uses Dear ImGui. This is because some compile-time options have an affect on data structures. +// Defining those options in imconfig.h will ensure every compilation unit gets to see the same data structure layouts. +// Call IMGUI_CHECKVERSION() from your .cpp files to verify that the data structures your files are using are matching the ones imgui.cpp is using. +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +#pragma once + +//---- Define assertion handler. Defaults to calling assert(). +// If your macro uses multiple statements, make sure is enclosed in a 'do { .. } while (0)' block so it can be used as a single statement. +//#define IM_ASSERT(_EXPR) MyAssert(_EXPR) +//#define IM_ASSERT(_EXPR) ((void)(_EXPR)) // Disable asserts + +//---- Define attributes of all API symbols declarations, e.g. for DLL under Windows +// Using Dear ImGui via a shared library is not recommended, because of function call overhead and because we don't guarantee backward nor forward ABI compatibility. +// DLL users: heaps and globals are not shared across DLL boundaries! You will need to call SetCurrentContext() + SetAllocatorFunctions() +// for each static/DLL boundary you are calling from. Read "Context and Memory Allocators" section of imgui.cpp for more details. +//#define IMGUI_API __declspec( dllexport ) +//#define IMGUI_API __declspec( dllimport ) + +//---- Don't define obsolete functions/enums/behaviors. Consider enabling from time to time after updating to avoid using soon-to-be obsolete function/names. +//#define IMGUI_DISABLE_OBSOLETE_FUNCTIONS + +//---- Disable all of Dear ImGui or don't implement standard windows. +// It is very strongly recommended to NOT disable the demo windows during development. Please read comments in imgui_demo.cpp. +//#define IMGUI_DISABLE // Disable everything: all headers and source files will be empty. +//#define IMGUI_DISABLE_DEMO_WINDOWS // Disable demo windows: ShowDemoWindow()/ShowStyleEditor() will be empty. Not recommended. +//#define IMGUI_DISABLE_METRICS_WINDOW // Disable metrics/debugger window: ShowMetricsWindow() will be empty. + +//---- Don't implement some functions to reduce linkage requirements. +//#define IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_DEFAULT_CLIPBOARD_FUNCTIONS // [Win32] Don't implement default clipboard handler. Won't use and link with OpenClipboard/GetClipboardData/CloseClipboard etc. (user32.lib/.a, kernel32.lib/.a) +//#define IMGUI_ENABLE_WIN32_DEFAULT_IME_FUNCTIONS // [Win32] [Default with Visual Studio] Implement default IME handler (require imm32.lib/.a, auto-link for Visual Studio, -limm32 on command-line for MinGW) +//#define IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_DEFAULT_IME_FUNCTIONS // [Win32] [Default with non-Visual Studio compilers] Don't implement default IME handler (won't require imm32.lib/.a) +//#define IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_FUNCTIONS // [Win32] Won't use and link with any Win32 function (clipboard, ime). +//#define IMGUI_ENABLE_OSX_DEFAULT_CLIPBOARD_FUNCTIONS // [OSX] Implement default OSX clipboard handler (need to link with '-framework ApplicationServices', this is why this is not the default). +//#define IMGUI_DISABLE_DEFAULT_FORMAT_FUNCTIONS // Don't implement ImFormatString/ImFormatStringV so you can implement them yourself (e.g. if you don't want to link with vsnprintf) +//#define IMGUI_DISABLE_DEFAULT_MATH_FUNCTIONS // Don't implement ImFabs/ImSqrt/ImPow/ImFmod/ImCos/ImSin/ImAcos/ImAtan2 so you can implement them yourself. +//#define IMGUI_DISABLE_FILE_FUNCTIONS // Don't implement ImFileOpen/ImFileClose/ImFileRead/ImFileWrite and ImFileHandle at all (replace them with dummies) +//#define IMGUI_DISABLE_DEFAULT_FILE_FUNCTIONS // Don't implement ImFileOpen/ImFileClose/ImFileRead/ImFileWrite and ImFileHandle so you can implement them yourself if you don't want to link with fopen/fclose/fread/fwrite. This will also disable the LogToTTY() function. +//#define IMGUI_DISABLE_DEFAULT_ALLOCATORS // Don't implement default allocators calling malloc()/free() to avoid linking with them. You will need to call ImGui::SetAllocatorFunctions(). +//#define IMGUI_DISABLE_SSE // Disable use of SSE intrinsics even if available + +//---- Include imgui_user.h at the end of imgui.h as a convenience +//#define IMGUI_INCLUDE_IMGUI_USER_H + +//---- Pack colors to BGRA8 instead of RGBA8 (to avoid converting from one to another) +//#define IMGUI_USE_BGRA_PACKED_COLOR + +//---- Use 32-bit for ImWchar (default is 16-bit) to support unicode planes 1-16. (e.g. point beyond 0xFFFF like emoticons, dingbats, symbols, shapes, ancient languages, etc...) +//#define IMGUI_USE_WCHAR32 + +//---- Avoid multiple STB libraries implementations, or redefine path/filenames to prioritize another version +// By default the embedded implementations are declared static and not available outside of Dear ImGui sources files. +//#define IMGUI_STB_TRUETYPE_FILENAME "my_folder/stb_truetype.h" +//#define IMGUI_STB_RECT_PACK_FILENAME "my_folder/stb_rect_pack.h" +//#define IMGUI_DISABLE_STB_TRUETYPE_IMPLEMENTATION +//#define IMGUI_DISABLE_STB_RECT_PACK_IMPLEMENTATION + +//---- Use stb_printf's faster implementation of vsnprintf instead of the one from libc (unless IMGUI_DISABLE_DEFAULT_FORMAT_FUNCTIONS is defined) +// Requires 'stb_sprintf.h' to be available in the include path. Compatibility checks of arguments and formats done by clang and GCC will be disabled in order to support the extra formats provided by STB sprintf. +// #define IMGUI_USE_STB_SPRINTF + +//---- Use FreeType to build and rasterize the font atlas (instead of stb_truetype which is embedded by default in Dear ImGui) +// Requires FreeType headers to be available in the include path. Requires program to be compiled with 'misc/freetype/imgui_freetype.cpp' (in this repository) + the FreeType library (not provided). +// On Windows you may use vcpkg with 'vcpkg install freetype --triplet=x64-windows' + 'vcpkg integrate install'. +//#define IMGUI_ENABLE_FREETYPE + +//---- Use stb_truetype to build and rasterize the font atlas (default) +// The only purpose of this define is if you want force compilation of the stb_truetype backend ALONG with the FreeType backend. +//#define IMGUI_ENABLE_STB_TRUETYPE + +//---- Define constructor and implicit cast operators to convert back<>forth between your math types and ImVec2/ImVec4. +// This will be inlined as part of ImVec2 and ImVec4 class declarations. +/* +#define IM_VEC2_CLASS_EXTRA \ + ImVec2(const MyVec2& f) { x = f.x; y = f.y; } \ + operator MyVec2() const { return MyVec2(x,y); } + +#define IM_VEC4_CLASS_EXTRA \ + ImVec4(const MyVec4& f) { x = f.x; y = f.y; z = f.z; w = f.w; } \ + operator MyVec4() const { return MyVec4(x,y,z,w); } +*/ + +//---- Use 32-bit vertex indices (default is 16-bit) is one way to allow large meshes with more than 64K vertices. +// Your renderer backend will need to support it (most example renderer backends support both 16/32-bit indices). +// Another way to allow large meshes while keeping 16-bit indices is to handle ImDrawCmd::VtxOffset in your renderer. +// Read about ImGuiBackendFlags_RendererHasVtxOffset for details. +//#define ImDrawIdx unsigned int + +//---- Override ImDrawCallback signature (will need to modify renderer backends accordingly) +//struct ImDrawList; +//struct ImDrawCmd; +//typedef void (*MyImDrawCallback)(const ImDrawList* draw_list, const ImDrawCmd* cmd, void* my_renderer_user_data); +//#define ImDrawCallback MyImDrawCallback + +//---- Debug Tools: Macro to break in Debugger +// (use 'Metrics->Tools->Item Picker' to pick widgets with the mouse and break into them for easy debugging.) +//#define IM_DEBUG_BREAK IM_ASSERT(0) +//#define IM_DEBUG_BREAK __debugbreak() + +//---- Debug Tools: Have the Item Picker break in the ItemAdd() function instead of ItemHoverable(), +// (which comes earlier in the code, will catch a few extra items, allow picking items other than Hovered one.) +// This adds a small runtime cost which is why it is not enabled by default. +//#define IMGUI_DEBUG_TOOL_ITEM_PICKER_EX + +//---- Debug Tools: Enable slower asserts +//#define IMGUI_DEBUG_PARANOID + +//---- Tip: You can add extra functions within the ImGui:: namespace, here or in your own headers files. +/* +namespace ImGui +{ + void MyFunction(const char* name, const MyMatrix44& v); +} +*/ diff --git a/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/imgui-1.84.2/imgui.cpp b/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/imgui-1.84.2/imgui.cpp new file mode 100644 index 0000000..ab27f13 --- /dev/null +++ b/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/imgui-1.84.2/imgui.cpp @@ -0,0 +1,11811 @@ +// dear imgui, v1.84 +// (main code and documentation) + +// Help: +// - Read FAQ at http://dearimgui.org/faq +// - Newcomers, read 'Programmer guide' below for notes on how to setup Dear ImGui in your codebase. +// - Call and read ImGui::ShowDemoWindow() in imgui_demo.cpp. All applications in examples/ are doing that. +// Read imgui.cpp for details, links and comments. + +// Resources: +// - FAQ http://dearimgui.org/faq +// - Homepage & latest https://github.com/ocornut/imgui +// - Releases & changelog https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/releases +// - Gallery https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/issues/4451 (please post your screenshots/video there!) +// - Wiki https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/wiki (lots of good stuff there) +// - Glossary https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/wiki/Glossary +// - Issues & support https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/issues +// - Discussions https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/discussions + +// Developed by Omar Cornut and every direct or indirect contributors to the GitHub. +// See LICENSE.txt for copyright and licensing details (standard MIT License). +// This library is free but needs your support to sustain development and maintenance. +// Businesses: you can support continued development via invoiced technical support, maintenance and sponsoring contracts. Please reach out to "contact AT dearimgui.com". +// Individuals: you can support continued development via donations. See docs/README or web page. + +// It is recommended that you don't modify imgui.cpp! It will become difficult for you to update the library. +// Note that 'ImGui::' being a namespace, you can add functions into the namespace from your own source files, without +// modifying imgui.h or imgui.cpp. You may include imgui_internal.h to access internal data structures, but it doesn't +// come with any guarantee of forward compatibility. Discussing your changes on the GitHub Issue Tracker may lead you +// to a better solution or official support for them. + +/* + +Index of this file: + +DOCUMENTATION + +- MISSION STATEMENT +- END-USER GUIDE +- PROGRAMMER GUIDE + - READ FIRST + - HOW TO UPDATE TO A NEWER VERSION OF DEAR IMGUI + - GETTING STARTED WITH INTEGRATING DEAR IMGUI IN YOUR CODE/ENGINE + - HOW A SIMPLE APPLICATION MAY LOOK LIKE + - HOW A SIMPLE RENDERING FUNCTION MAY LOOK LIKE + - USING GAMEPAD/KEYBOARD NAVIGATION CONTROLS +- API BREAKING CHANGES (read me when you update!) +- FREQUENTLY ASKED QUESTIONS (FAQ) + - Read all answers online: https://www.dearimgui.org/faq, or in docs/FAQ.md (with a Markdown viewer) + +CODE +(search for "[SECTION]" in the code to find them) + +// [SECTION] INCLUDES +// [SECTION] FORWARD DECLARATIONS +// [SECTION] CONTEXT AND MEMORY ALLOCATORS +// [SECTION] USER FACING STRUCTURES (ImGuiStyle, ImGuiIO) +// [SECTION] MISC HELPERS/UTILITIES (Geometry functions) +// [SECTION] MISC HELPERS/UTILITIES (String, Format, Hash functions) +// [SECTION] MISC HELPERS/UTILITIES (File functions) +// [SECTION] MISC HELPERS/UTILITIES (ImText* functions) +// [SECTION] MISC HELPERS/UTILITIES (Color functions) +// [SECTION] ImGuiStorage +// [SECTION] ImGuiTextFilter +// [SECTION] ImGuiTextBuffer +// [SECTION] ImGuiListClipper +// [SECTION] STYLING +// [SECTION] RENDER HELPERS +// [SECTION] MAIN CODE (most of the code! lots of stuff, needs tidying up!) +// [SECTION] ERROR CHECKING +// [SECTION] LAYOUT +// [SECTION] SCROLLING +// [SECTION] TOOLTIPS +// [SECTION] POPUPS +// [SECTION] KEYBOARD/GAMEPAD NAVIGATION +// [SECTION] DRAG AND DROP +// [SECTION] LOGGING/CAPTURING +// [SECTION] SETTINGS +// [SECTION] VIEWPORTS +// [SECTION] PLATFORM DEPENDENT HELPERS +// [SECTION] METRICS/DEBUGGER WINDOW + +*/ + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// DOCUMENTATION +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +/* + + MISSION STATEMENT + ================= + + - Easy to use to create code-driven and data-driven tools. + - Easy to use to create ad hoc short-lived tools and long-lived, more elaborate tools. + - Easy to hack and improve. + - Minimize setup and maintenance. + - Minimize state storage on user side. + - Portable, minimize dependencies, run on target (consoles, phones, etc.). + - Efficient runtime and memory consumption. + + Designed for developers and content-creators, not the typical end-user! Some of the current weaknesses includes: + + - Doesn't look fancy, doesn't animate. + - Limited layout features, intricate layouts are typically crafted in code. + + + END-USER GUIDE + ============== + + - Double-click on title bar to collapse window. + - Click upper right corner to close a window, available when 'bool* p_open' is passed to ImGui::Begin(). + - Click and drag on lower right corner to resize window (double-click to auto fit window to its contents). + - Click and drag on any empty space to move window. + - TAB/SHIFT+TAB to cycle through keyboard editable fields. + - CTRL+Click on a slider or drag box to input value as text. + - Use mouse wheel to scroll. + - Text editor: + - Hold SHIFT or use mouse to select text. + - CTRL+Left/Right to word jump. + - CTRL+Shift+Left/Right to select words. + - CTRL+A our Double-Click to select all. + - CTRL+X,CTRL+C,CTRL+V to use OS clipboard/ + - CTRL+Z,CTRL+Y to undo/redo. + - ESCAPE to revert text to its original value. + - You can apply arithmetic operators +,*,/ on numerical values. Use +- to subtract (because - would set a negative value!) + - Controls are automatically adjusted for OSX to match standard OSX text editing operations. + - General Keyboard controls: enable with ImGuiConfigFlags_NavEnableKeyboard. + - General Gamepad controls: enable with ImGuiConfigFlags_NavEnableGamepad. See suggested mappings in imgui.h ImGuiNavInput_ + download PNG/PSD at http://dearimgui.org/controls_sheets + + + PROGRAMMER GUIDE + ================ + + READ FIRST + ---------- + - Remember to check the wonderful Wiki (https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/wiki) + - Your code creates the UI, if your code doesn't run the UI is gone! The UI can be highly dynamic, there are no construction or + destruction steps, less superfluous data retention on your side, less state duplication, less state synchronization, fewer bugs. + - Call and read ImGui::ShowDemoWindow() for demo code demonstrating most features. + - The library is designed to be built from sources. Avoid pre-compiled binaries and packaged versions. See imconfig.h to configure your build. + - Dear ImGui is an implementation of the IMGUI paradigm (immediate-mode graphical user interface, a term coined by Casey Muratori). + You can learn about IMGUI principles at http://www.johno.se/book/imgui.html, http://mollyrocket.com/861 & more links in Wiki. + - Dear ImGui is a "single pass" rasterizing implementation of the IMGUI paradigm, aimed at ease of use and high-performances. + For every application frame, your UI code will be called only once. This is in contrast to e.g. Unity's implementation of an IMGUI, + where the UI code is called multiple times ("multiple passes") from a single entry point. There are pros and cons to both approaches. + - Our origin is on the top-left. In axis aligned bounding boxes, Min = top-left, Max = bottom-right. + - This codebase is also optimized to yield decent performances with typical "Debug" builds settings. + - Please make sure you have asserts enabled (IM_ASSERT redirects to assert() by default, but can be redirected). + If you get an assert, read the messages and comments around the assert. + - C++: this is a very C-ish codebase: we don't rely on C++11, we don't include any C++ headers, and ImGui:: is a namespace. + - C++: ImVec2/ImVec4 do not expose math operators by default, because it is expected that you use your own math types. + See FAQ "How can I use my own math types instead of ImVec2/ImVec4?" for details about setting up imconfig.h for that. + However, imgui_internal.h can optionally export math operators for ImVec2/ImVec4, which we use in this codebase. + - C++: pay attention that ImVector<> manipulates plain-old-data and does not honor construction/destruction (avoid using it in your code!). + + + HOW TO UPDATE TO A NEWER VERSION OF DEAR IMGUI + ---------------------------------------------- + - Overwrite all the sources files except for imconfig.h (if you have modified your copy of imconfig.h) + - Or maintain your own branch where you have imconfig.h modified as a top-most commit which you can regularly rebase over "master". + - You can also use '#define IMGUI_USER_CONFIG "my_config_file.h" to redirect configuration to your own file. + - Read the "API BREAKING CHANGES" section (below). This is where we list occasional API breaking changes. + If a function/type has been renamed / or marked obsolete, try to fix the name in your code before it is permanently removed + from the public API. If you have a problem with a missing function/symbols, search for its name in the code, there will + likely be a comment about it. Please report any issue to the GitHub page! + - To find out usage of old API, you can add '#define IMGUI_DISABLE_OBSOLETE_FUNCTIONS' in your configuration file. + - Try to keep your copy of Dear ImGui reasonably up to date. + + + GETTING STARTED WITH INTEGRATING DEAR IMGUI IN YOUR CODE/ENGINE + --------------------------------------------------------------- + - Run and study the examples and demo in imgui_demo.cpp to get acquainted with the library. + - In the majority of cases you should be able to use unmodified backends files available in the backends/ folder. + - Add the Dear ImGui source files + selected backend source files to your projects or using your preferred build system. + It is recommended you build and statically link the .cpp files as part of your project and NOT as a shared library (DLL). + - You can later customize the imconfig.h file to tweak some compile-time behavior, such as integrating Dear ImGui types with your own maths types. + - When using Dear ImGui, your programming IDE is your friend: follow the declaration of variables, functions and types to find comments about them. + - Dear ImGui never touches or knows about your GPU state. The only function that knows about GPU is the draw function that you provide. + Effectively it means you can create widgets at any time in your code, regardless of considerations of being in "update" vs "render" + phases of your own application. All rendering information is stored into command-lists that you will retrieve after calling ImGui::Render(). + - Refer to the backends and demo applications in the examples/ folder for instruction on how to setup your code. + - If you are running over a standard OS with a common graphics API, you should be able to use unmodified imgui_impl_*** files from the examples/ folder. + + + HOW A SIMPLE APPLICATION MAY LOOK LIKE + -------------------------------------- + EXHIBIT 1: USING THE EXAMPLE BACKENDS (= imgui_impl_XXX.cpp files from the backends/ folder). + The sub-folders in examples/ contain examples applications following this structure. + + // Application init: create a dear imgui context, setup some options, load fonts + ImGui::CreateContext(); + ImGuiIO& io = ImGui::GetIO(); + // TODO: Set optional io.ConfigFlags values, e.g. 'io.ConfigFlags |= ImGuiConfigFlags_NavEnableKeyboard' to enable keyboard controls. + // TODO: Fill optional fields of the io structure later. + // TODO: Load TTF/OTF fonts if you don't want to use the default font. + + // Initialize helper Platform and Renderer backends (here we are using imgui_impl_win32.cpp and imgui_impl_dx11.cpp) + ImGui_ImplWin32_Init(hwnd); + ImGui_ImplDX11_Init(g_pd3dDevice, g_pd3dDeviceContext); + + // Application main loop + while (true) + { + // Feed inputs to dear imgui, start new frame + ImGui_ImplDX11_NewFrame(); + ImGui_ImplWin32_NewFrame(); + ImGui::NewFrame(); + + // Any application code here + ImGui::Text("Hello, world!"); + + // Render dear imgui into screen + ImGui::Render(); + ImGui_ImplDX11_RenderDrawData(ImGui::GetDrawData()); + g_pSwapChain->Present(1, 0); + } + + // Shutdown + ImGui_ImplDX11_Shutdown(); + ImGui_ImplWin32_Shutdown(); + ImGui::DestroyContext(); + + EXHIBIT 2: IMPLEMENTING CUSTOM BACKEND / CUSTOM ENGINE + + // Application init: create a dear imgui context, setup some options, load fonts + ImGui::CreateContext(); + ImGuiIO& io = ImGui::GetIO(); + // TODO: Set optional io.ConfigFlags values, e.g. 'io.ConfigFlags |= ImGuiConfigFlags_NavEnableKeyboard' to enable keyboard controls. + // TODO: Fill optional fields of the io structure later. + // TODO: Load TTF/OTF fonts if you don't want to use the default font. + + // Build and load the texture atlas into a texture + // (In the examples/ app this is usually done within the ImGui_ImplXXX_Init() function from one of the demo Renderer) + int width, height; + unsigned char* pixels = NULL; + io.Fonts->GetTexDataAsRGBA32(&pixels, &width, &height); + + // At this point you've got the texture data and you need to upload that to your graphic system: + // After we have created the texture, store its pointer/identifier (_in whichever format your engine uses_) in 'io.Fonts->TexID'. + // This will be passed back to your via the renderer. Basically ImTextureID == void*. Read FAQ for details about ImTextureID. + MyTexture* texture = MyEngine::CreateTextureFromMemoryPixels(pixels, width, height, TEXTURE_TYPE_RGBA32) + io.Fonts->SetTexID((void*)texture); + + // Application main loop + while (true) + { + // Setup low-level inputs, e.g. on Win32: calling GetKeyboardState(), or write to those fields from your Windows message handlers, etc. + // (In the examples/ app this is usually done within the ImGui_ImplXXX_NewFrame() function from one of the demo Platform Backends) + io.DeltaTime = 1.0f/60.0f; // set the time elapsed since the previous frame (in seconds) + io.DisplaySize.x = 1920.0f; // set the current display width + io.DisplaySize.y = 1280.0f; // set the current display height here + io.MousePos = my_mouse_pos; // set the mouse position + io.MouseDown[0] = my_mouse_buttons[0]; // set the mouse button states + io.MouseDown[1] = my_mouse_buttons[1]; + + // Call NewFrame(), after this point you can use ImGui::* functions anytime + // (So you want to try calling NewFrame() as early as you can in your main loop to be able to use Dear ImGui everywhere) + ImGui::NewFrame(); + + // Most of your application code here + ImGui::Text("Hello, world!"); + MyGameUpdate(); // may use any Dear ImGui functions, e.g. ImGui::Begin("My window"); ImGui::Text("Hello, world!"); ImGui::End(); + MyGameRender(); // may use any Dear ImGui functions as well! + + // Render dear imgui, swap buffers + // (You want to try calling EndFrame/Render as late as you can, to be able to use Dear ImGui in your own game rendering code) + ImGui::EndFrame(); + ImGui::Render(); + ImDrawData* draw_data = ImGui::GetDrawData(); + MyImGuiRenderFunction(draw_data); + SwapBuffers(); + } + + // Shutdown + ImGui::DestroyContext(); + + To decide whether to dispatch mouse/keyboard inputs to Dear ImGui to the rest of your application, + you should read the 'io.WantCaptureMouse', 'io.WantCaptureKeyboard' and 'io.WantTextInput' flags! + Please read the FAQ and example applications for details about this! + + + HOW A SIMPLE RENDERING FUNCTION MAY LOOK LIKE + --------------------------------------------- + The backends in impl_impl_XXX.cpp files contain many working implementations of a rendering function. + + void void MyImGuiRenderFunction(ImDrawData* draw_data) + { + // TODO: Setup render state: alpha-blending enabled, no face culling, no depth testing, scissor enabled + // TODO: Setup viewport covering draw_data->DisplayPos to draw_data->DisplayPos + draw_data->DisplaySize + // TODO: Setup orthographic projection matrix cover draw_data->DisplayPos to draw_data->DisplayPos + draw_data->DisplaySize + // TODO: Setup shader: vertex { float2 pos, float2 uv, u32 color }, fragment shader sample color from 1 texture, multiply by vertex color. + for (int n = 0; n < draw_data->CmdListsCount; n++) + { + const ImDrawList* cmd_list = draw_data->CmdLists[n]; + const ImDrawVert* vtx_buffer = cmd_list->VtxBuffer.Data; // vertex buffer generated by Dear ImGui + const ImDrawIdx* idx_buffer = cmd_list->IdxBuffer.Data; // index buffer generated by Dear ImGui + for (int cmd_i = 0; cmd_i < cmd_list->CmdBuffer.Size; cmd_i++) + { + const ImDrawCmd* pcmd = &cmd_list->CmdBuffer[cmd_i]; + if (pcmd->UserCallback) + { + pcmd->UserCallback(cmd_list, pcmd); + } + else + { + // The texture for the draw call is specified by pcmd->GetTexID(). + // The vast majority of draw calls will use the Dear ImGui texture atlas, which value you have set yourself during initialization. + MyEngineBindTexture((MyTexture*)pcmd->GetTexID()); + + // We are using scissoring to clip some objects. All low-level graphics API should support it. + // - If your engine doesn't support scissoring yet, you may ignore this at first. You will get some small glitches + // (some elements visible outside their bounds) but you can fix that once everything else works! + // - Clipping coordinates are provided in imgui coordinates space: + // - For a given viewport, draw_data->DisplayPos == viewport->Pos and draw_data->DisplaySize == viewport->Size + // - In a single viewport application, draw_data->DisplayPos == (0,0) and draw_data->DisplaySize == io.DisplaySize, but always use GetMainViewport()->Pos/Size instead of hardcoding those values. + // - In the interest of supporting multi-viewport applications (see 'docking' branch on github), + // always subtract draw_data->DisplayPos from clipping bounds to convert them to your viewport space. + // - Note that pcmd->ClipRect contains Min+Max bounds. Some graphics API may use Min+Max, other may use Min+Size (size being Max-Min) + ImVec2 pos = draw_data->DisplayPos; + MyEngineScissor((int)(pcmd->ClipRect.x - pos.x), (int)(pcmd->ClipRect.y - pos.y), (int)(pcmd->ClipRect.z - pos.x), (int)(pcmd->ClipRect.w - pos.y)); + + // Render 'pcmd->ElemCount/3' indexed triangles. + // By default the indices ImDrawIdx are 16-bit, you can change them to 32-bit in imconfig.h if your engine doesn't support 16-bit indices. + MyEngineDrawIndexedTriangles(pcmd->ElemCount, sizeof(ImDrawIdx) == 2 ? GL_UNSIGNED_SHORT : GL_UNSIGNED_INT, idx_buffer, vtx_buffer); + } + idx_buffer += pcmd->ElemCount; + } + } + } + + + USING GAMEPAD/KEYBOARD NAVIGATION CONTROLS + ------------------------------------------ + - The gamepad/keyboard navigation is fairly functional and keeps being improved. + - Gamepad support is particularly useful to use Dear ImGui on a console system (e.g. PS4, Switch, XB1) without a mouse! + - You can ask questions and report issues at https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/issues/787 + - The initial focus was to support game controllers, but keyboard is becoming increasingly and decently usable. + - Keyboard: + - Set io.ConfigFlags |= ImGuiConfigFlags_NavEnableKeyboard to enable. + NewFrame() will automatically fill io.NavInputs[] based on your io.KeysDown[] + io.KeyMap[] arrays. + - When keyboard navigation is active (io.NavActive + ImGuiConfigFlags_NavEnableKeyboard), the io.WantCaptureKeyboard flag + will be set. For more advanced uses, you may want to read from: + - io.NavActive: true when a window is focused and it doesn't have the ImGuiWindowFlags_NoNavInputs flag set. + - io.NavVisible: true when the navigation cursor is visible (and usually goes false when mouse is used). + - or query focus information with e.g. IsWindowFocused(ImGuiFocusedFlags_AnyWindow), IsItemFocused() etc. functions. + Please reach out if you think the game vs navigation input sharing could be improved. + - Gamepad: + - Set io.ConfigFlags |= ImGuiConfigFlags_NavEnableGamepad to enable. + - Backend: Set io.BackendFlags |= ImGuiBackendFlags_HasGamepad + fill the io.NavInputs[] fields before calling NewFrame(). + Note that io.NavInputs[] is cleared by EndFrame(). + - See 'enum ImGuiNavInput_' in imgui.h for a description of inputs. For each entry of io.NavInputs[], set the following values: + 0.0f= not held. 1.0f= fully held. Pass intermediate 0.0f..1.0f values for analog triggers/sticks. + - We use a simple >0.0f test for activation testing, and won't attempt to test for a dead-zone. + Your code will probably need to transform your raw inputs (such as e.g. remapping your 0.2..0.9 raw input range to 0.0..1.0 imgui range, etc.). + - You can download PNG/PSD files depicting the gamepad controls for common controllers at: http://dearimgui.org/controls_sheets + - If you need to share inputs between your game and the imgui parts, the easiest approach is to go all-or-nothing, with a buttons combo + to toggle the target. Please reach out if you think the game vs navigation input sharing could be improved. + - Mouse: + - PS4 users: Consider emulating a mouse cursor with DualShock4 touch pad or a spare analog stick as a mouse-emulation fallback. + - Consoles/Tablet/Phone users: Consider using a Synergy 1.x server (on your PC) + uSynergy.c (on your console/tablet/phone app) to share your PC mouse/keyboard. + - On a TV/console system where readability may be lower or mouse inputs may be awkward, you may want to set the ImGuiConfigFlags_NavEnableSetMousePos flag. + Enabling ImGuiConfigFlags_NavEnableSetMousePos + ImGuiBackendFlags_HasSetMousePos instructs dear imgui to move your mouse cursor along with navigation movements. + When enabled, the NewFrame() function may alter 'io.MousePos' and set 'io.WantSetMousePos' to notify you that it wants the mouse cursor to be moved. + When that happens your backend NEEDS to move the OS or underlying mouse cursor on the next frame. Some of the backends in examples/ do that. + (If you set the NavEnableSetMousePos flag but don't honor 'io.WantSetMousePos' properly, imgui will misbehave as it will see your mouse moving back and forth!) + (In a setup when you may not have easy control over the mouse cursor, e.g. uSynergy.c doesn't expose moving remote mouse cursor, you may want + to set a boolean to ignore your other external mouse positions until the external source is moved again.) + + + API BREAKING CHANGES + ==================== + + Occasionally introducing changes that are breaking the API. We try to make the breakage minor and easy to fix. + Below is a change-log of API breaking changes only. If you are using one of the functions listed, expect to have to fix some code. + When you are not sure about an old symbol or function name, try using the Search/Find function of your IDE to look for comments or references in all imgui files. + You can read releases logs https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/releases for more details. + + - 2021/07/26 (1.84) - commented out redirecting functions/enums names that were marked obsolete in 1.67 and 1.69 (March 2019): + - ImGui::GetOverlayDrawList() -> use ImGui::GetForegroundDrawList() + - ImFont::GlyphRangesBuilder -> use ImFontGlyphRangesBuilder + - 2021/05/19 (1.83) - backends: obsoleted direct access to ImDrawCmd::TextureId in favor of calling ImDrawCmd::GetTexID(). + - if you are using official backends from the source tree: you have nothing to do. + - if you have copied old backend code or using your own: change access to draw_cmd->TextureId to draw_cmd->GetTexID(). + - 2021/03/12 (1.82) - upgraded ImDrawList::AddRect(), AddRectFilled(), PathRect() to use ImDrawFlags instead of ImDrawCornersFlags. + - ImDrawCornerFlags_TopLeft -> use ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersTopLeft + - ImDrawCornerFlags_BotRight -> use ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersBottomRight + - ImDrawCornerFlags_None -> use ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersNone etc. + flags now sanely defaults to 0 instead of 0x0F, consistent with all other flags in the API. + breaking: the default with rounding > 0.0f is now "round all corners" vs old implicit "round no corners": + - rounding == 0.0f + flags == 0 --> meant no rounding --> unchanged (common use) + - rounding > 0.0f + flags != 0 --> meant rounding --> unchanged (common use) + - rounding == 0.0f + flags != 0 --> meant no rounding --> unchanged (unlikely use) + - rounding > 0.0f + flags == 0 --> meant no rounding --> BREAKING (unlikely use): will now round all corners --> use ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersNone or rounding == 0.0f. + this ONLY matters for hard coded use of 0 + rounding > 0.0f. Use of named ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersNone (new) or ImDrawCornerFlags_None (old) are ok. + the old ImDrawCornersFlags used awkward default values of ~0 or 0xF (4 lower bits set) to signify "round all corners" and we sometimes encouraged using them as shortcuts. + legacy path still support use of hard coded ~0 or any value from 0x1 or 0xF. They will behave the same with legacy paths enabled (will assert otherwise). + - 2021/03/11 (1.82) - removed redirecting functions/enums names that were marked obsolete in 1.66 (September 2018): + - ImGui::SetScrollHere() -> use ImGui::SetScrollHereY() + - 2021/03/11 (1.82) - clarified that ImDrawList::PathArcTo(), ImDrawList::PathArcToFast() won't render with radius < 0.0f. Previously it sorts of accidentally worked but would generally lead to counter-clockwise paths and have an effect on anti-aliasing. + - 2021/03/10 (1.82) - upgraded ImDrawList::AddPolyline() and PathStroke() "bool closed" parameter to "ImDrawFlags flags". The matching ImDrawFlags_Closed value is guaranteed to always stay == 1 in the future. + - 2021/02/22 (1.82) - (*undone in 1.84*) win32+mingw: Re-enabled IME functions by default even under MinGW. In July 2016, issue #738 had me incorrectly disable those default functions for MinGW. MinGW users should: either link with -limm32, either set their imconfig file with '#define IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_DEFAULT_IME_FUNCTIONS'. + - 2021/02/17 (1.82) - renamed rarely used style.CircleSegmentMaxError (old default = 1.60f) to style.CircleTessellationMaxError (new default = 0.30f) as the meaning of the value changed. + - 2021/02/03 (1.81) - renamed ListBoxHeader(const char* label, ImVec2 size) to BeginListBox(). Kept inline redirection function (will obsolete). + - removed ListBoxHeader(const char* label, int items_count, int height_in_items = -1) in favor of specifying size. Kept inline redirection function (will obsolete). + - renamed ListBoxFooter() to EndListBox(). Kept inline redirection function (will obsolete). + - 2021/01/26 (1.81) - removed ImGuiFreeType::BuildFontAtlas(). Kept inline redirection function. Prefer using '#define IMGUI_ENABLE_FREETYPE', but there's a runtime selection path available too. The shared extra flags parameters (very rarely used) are now stored in ImFontAtlas::FontBuilderFlags. + - renamed ImFontConfig::RasterizerFlags (used by FreeType) to ImFontConfig::FontBuilderFlags. + - renamed ImGuiFreeType::XXX flags to ImGuiFreeTypeBuilderFlags_XXX for consistency with other API. + - 2020/10/12 (1.80) - removed redirecting functions/enums that were marked obsolete in 1.63 (August 2018): + - ImGui::IsItemDeactivatedAfterChange() -> use ImGui::IsItemDeactivatedAfterEdit(). + - ImGuiCol_ModalWindowDarkening -> use ImGuiCol_ModalWindowDimBg + - ImGuiInputTextCallback -> use ImGuiTextEditCallback + - ImGuiInputTextCallbackData -> use ImGuiTextEditCallbackData + - 2020/12/21 (1.80) - renamed ImDrawList::AddBezierCurve() to AddBezierCubic(), and PathBezierCurveTo() to PathBezierCubicCurveTo(). Kept inline redirection function (will obsolete). + - 2020/12/04 (1.80) - added imgui_tables.cpp file! Manually constructed project files will need the new file added! + - 2020/11/18 (1.80) - renamed undocumented/internals ImGuiColumnsFlags_* to ImGuiOldColumnFlags_* in prevision of incoming Tables API. + - 2020/11/03 (1.80) - renamed io.ConfigWindowsMemoryCompactTimer to io.ConfigMemoryCompactTimer as the feature will apply to other data structures + - 2020/10/14 (1.80) - backends: moved all backends files (imgui_impl_XXXX.cpp, imgui_impl_XXXX.h) from examples/ to backends/. + - 2020/10/12 (1.80) - removed redirecting functions/enums that were marked obsolete in 1.60 (April 2018): + - io.RenderDrawListsFn pointer -> use ImGui::GetDrawData() value and call the render function of your backend + - ImGui::IsAnyWindowFocused() -> use ImGui::IsWindowFocused(ImGuiFocusedFlags_AnyWindow) + - ImGui::IsAnyWindowHovered() -> use ImGui::IsWindowHovered(ImGuiHoveredFlags_AnyWindow) + - ImGuiStyleVar_Count_ -> use ImGuiStyleVar_COUNT + - ImGuiMouseCursor_Count_ -> use ImGuiMouseCursor_COUNT + - removed redirecting functions names that were marked obsolete in 1.61 (May 2018): + - InputFloat (... int decimal_precision ...) -> use InputFloat (... const char* format ...) with format = "%.Xf" where X is your value for decimal_precision. + - same for InputFloat2()/InputFloat3()/InputFloat4() variants taking a `int decimal_precision` parameter. + - 2020/10/05 (1.79) - removed ImGuiListClipper: Renamed constructor parameters which created an ambiguous alternative to using the ImGuiListClipper::Begin() function, with misleading edge cases (note: imgui_memory_editor <0.40 from imgui_club/ used this old clipper API. Update your copy if needed). + - 2020/09/25 (1.79) - renamed ImGuiSliderFlags_ClampOnInput to ImGuiSliderFlags_AlwaysClamp. Kept redirection enum (will obsolete sooner because previous name was added recently). + - 2020/09/25 (1.79) - renamed style.TabMinWidthForUnselectedCloseButton to style.TabMinWidthForCloseButton. + - 2020/09/21 (1.79) - renamed OpenPopupContextItem() back to OpenPopupOnItemClick(), reverting the change from 1.77. For varieties of reason this is more self-explanatory. + - 2020/09/21 (1.79) - removed return value from OpenPopupOnItemClick() - returned true on mouse release on an item - because it is inconsistent with other popup APIs and makes others misleading. It's also and unnecessary: you can use IsWindowAppearing() after BeginPopup() for a similar result. + - 2020/09/17 (1.79) - removed ImFont::DisplayOffset in favor of ImFontConfig::GlyphOffset. DisplayOffset was applied after scaling and not very meaningful/useful outside of being needed by the default ProggyClean font. If you scaled this value after calling AddFontDefault(), this is now done automatically. It was also getting in the way of better font scaling, so let's get rid of it now! + - 2020/08/17 (1.78) - obsoleted use of the trailing 'float power=1.0f' parameter for DragFloat(), DragFloat2(), DragFloat3(), DragFloat4(), DragFloatRange2(), DragScalar(), DragScalarN(), SliderFloat(), SliderFloat2(), SliderFloat3(), SliderFloat4(), SliderScalar(), SliderScalarN(), VSliderFloat() and VSliderScalar(). + replaced the 'float power=1.0f' argument with integer-based flags defaulting to 0 (as with all our flags). + worked out a backward-compatibility scheme so hopefully most C++ codebase should not be affected. in short, when calling those functions: + - if you omitted the 'power' parameter (likely!), you are not affected. + - if you set the 'power' parameter to 1.0f (same as previous default value): 1/ your compiler may warn on float>int conversion, 2/ everything else will work. 3/ you can replace the 1.0f value with 0 to fix the warning, and be technically correct. + - if you set the 'power' parameter to >1.0f (to enable non-linear editing): 1/ your compiler may warn on float>int conversion, 2/ code will assert at runtime, 3/ in case asserts are disabled, the code will not crash and enable the _Logarithmic flag. 4/ you can replace the >1.0f value with ImGuiSliderFlags_Logarithmic to fix the warning/assert and get a _similar_ effect as previous uses of power >1.0f. + see https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/issues/3361 for all details. + kept inline redirection functions (will obsolete) apart for: DragFloatRange2(), VSliderFloat(), VSliderScalar(). For those three the 'float power=1.0f' version was removed directly as they were most unlikely ever used. + for shared code, you can version check at compile-time with `#if IMGUI_VERSION_NUM >= 17704`. + - obsoleted use of v_min > v_max in DragInt, DragFloat, DragScalar to lock edits (introduced in 1.73, was not demoed nor documented very), will be replaced by a more generic ReadOnly feature. You may use the ImGuiSliderFlags_ReadOnly internal flag in the meantime. + - 2020/06/23 (1.77) - removed BeginPopupContextWindow(const char*, int mouse_button, bool also_over_items) in favor of BeginPopupContextWindow(const char*, ImGuiPopupFlags flags) with ImGuiPopupFlags_NoOverItems. + - 2020/06/15 (1.77) - renamed OpenPopupOnItemClick() to OpenPopupContextItem(). Kept inline redirection function (will obsolete). [NOTE: THIS WAS REVERTED IN 1.79] + - 2020/06/15 (1.77) - removed CalcItemRectClosestPoint() entry point which was made obsolete and asserting in December 2017. + - 2020/04/23 (1.77) - removed unnecessary ID (first arg) of ImFontAtlas::AddCustomRectRegular(). + - 2020/01/22 (1.75) - ImDrawList::AddCircle()/AddCircleFilled() functions don't accept negative radius any more. + - 2019/12/17 (1.75) - [undid this change in 1.76] made Columns() limited to 64 columns by asserting above that limit. While the current code technically supports it, future code may not so we're putting the restriction ahead. + - 2019/12/13 (1.75) - [imgui_internal.h] changed ImRect() default constructor initializes all fields to 0.0f instead of (FLT_MAX,FLT_MAX,-FLT_MAX,-FLT_MAX). If you used ImRect::Add() to create bounding boxes by adding multiple points into it, you may need to fix your initial value. + - 2019/12/08 (1.75) - removed redirecting functions/enums that were marked obsolete in 1.53 (December 2017): + - ShowTestWindow() -> use ShowDemoWindow() + - IsRootWindowFocused() -> use IsWindowFocused(ImGuiFocusedFlags_RootWindow) + - IsRootWindowOrAnyChildFocused() -> use IsWindowFocused(ImGuiFocusedFlags_RootAndChildWindows) + - SetNextWindowContentWidth(w) -> use SetNextWindowContentSize(ImVec2(w, 0.0f) + - GetItemsLineHeightWithSpacing() -> use GetFrameHeightWithSpacing() + - ImGuiCol_ChildWindowBg -> use ImGuiCol_ChildBg + - ImGuiStyleVar_ChildWindowRounding -> use ImGuiStyleVar_ChildRounding + - ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_AllowOverlapMode -> use ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_AllowItemOverlap + - IMGUI_DISABLE_TEST_WINDOWS -> use IMGUI_DISABLE_DEMO_WINDOWS + - 2019/12/08 (1.75) - obsoleted calling ImDrawList::PrimReserve() with a negative count (which was vaguely documented and rarely if ever used). Instead, we added an explicit PrimUnreserve() API. + - 2019/12/06 (1.75) - removed implicit default parameter to IsMouseDragging(int button = 0) to be consistent with other mouse functions (none of the other functions have it). + - 2019/11/21 (1.74) - ImFontAtlas::AddCustomRectRegular() now requires an ID larger than 0x110000 (instead of 0x10000) to conform with supporting Unicode planes 1-16 in a future update. ID below 0x110000 will now assert. + - 2019/11/19 (1.74) - renamed IMGUI_DISABLE_FORMAT_STRING_FUNCTIONS to IMGUI_DISABLE_DEFAULT_FORMAT_FUNCTIONS for consistency. + - 2019/11/19 (1.74) - renamed IMGUI_DISABLE_MATH_FUNCTIONS to IMGUI_DISABLE_DEFAULT_MATH_FUNCTIONS for consistency. + - 2019/10/22 (1.74) - removed redirecting functions/enums that were marked obsolete in 1.52 (October 2017): + - Begin() [old 5 args version] -> use Begin() [3 args], use SetNextWindowSize() SetNextWindowBgAlpha() if needed + - IsRootWindowOrAnyChildHovered() -> use IsWindowHovered(ImGuiHoveredFlags_RootAndChildWindows) + - AlignFirstTextHeightToWidgets() -> use AlignTextToFramePadding() + - SetNextWindowPosCenter() -> use SetNextWindowPos() with a pivot of (0.5f, 0.5f) + - ImFont::Glyph -> use ImFontGlyph + - 2019/10/14 (1.74) - inputs: Fixed a miscalculation in the keyboard/mouse "typematic" repeat delay/rate calculation, used by keys and e.g. repeating mouse buttons as well as the GetKeyPressedAmount() function. + if you were using a non-default value for io.KeyRepeatRate (previous default was 0.250), you can add +io.KeyRepeatDelay to it to compensate for the fix. + The function was triggering on: 0.0 and (delay+rate*N) where (N>=1). Fixed formula responds to (N>=0). Effectively it made io.KeyRepeatRate behave like it was set to (io.KeyRepeatRate + io.KeyRepeatDelay). + If you never altered io.KeyRepeatRate nor used GetKeyPressedAmount() this won't affect you. + - 2019/07/15 (1.72) - removed TreeAdvanceToLabelPos() which is rarely used and only does SetCursorPosX(GetCursorPosX() + GetTreeNodeToLabelSpacing()). Kept redirection function (will obsolete). + - 2019/07/12 (1.72) - renamed ImFontAtlas::CustomRect to ImFontAtlasCustomRect. Kept redirection typedef (will obsolete). + - 2019/06/14 (1.72) - removed redirecting functions/enums names that were marked obsolete in 1.51 (June 2017): ImGuiCol_Column*, ImGuiSetCond_*, IsItemHoveredRect(), IsPosHoveringAnyWindow(), IsMouseHoveringAnyWindow(), IsMouseHoveringWindow(), IMGUI_ONCE_UPON_A_FRAME. Grep this log for details and new names, or see how they were implemented until 1.71. + - 2019/06/07 (1.71) - rendering of child window outer decorations (bg color, border, scrollbars) is now performed as part of the parent window. If you have + overlapping child windows in a same parent, and relied on their relative z-order to be mapped to their submission order, this will affect your rendering. + This optimization is disabled if the parent window has no visual output, because it appears to be the most common situation leading to the creation of overlapping child windows. + Please reach out if you are affected. + - 2019/05/13 (1.71) - renamed SetNextTreeNodeOpen() to SetNextItemOpen(). Kept inline redirection function (will obsolete). + - 2019/05/11 (1.71) - changed io.AddInputCharacter(unsigned short c) signature to io.AddInputCharacter(unsigned int c). + - 2019/04/29 (1.70) - improved ImDrawList thick strokes (>1.0f) preserving correct thickness up to 90 degrees angles (e.g. rectangles). If you have custom rendering using thick lines, they will appear thicker now. + - 2019/04/29 (1.70) - removed GetContentRegionAvailWidth(), use GetContentRegionAvail().x instead. Kept inline redirection function (will obsolete). + - 2019/03/04 (1.69) - renamed GetOverlayDrawList() to GetForegroundDrawList(). Kept redirection function (will obsolete). + - 2019/02/26 (1.69) - renamed ImGuiColorEditFlags_RGB/ImGuiColorEditFlags_HSV/ImGuiColorEditFlags_HEX to ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayRGB/ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayHSV/ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayHex. Kept redirection enums (will obsolete). + - 2019/02/14 (1.68) - made it illegal/assert when io.DisplayTime == 0.0f (with an exception for the first frame). If for some reason your time step calculation gives you a zero value, replace it with an arbitrarily small value! + - 2019/02/01 (1.68) - removed io.DisplayVisibleMin/DisplayVisibleMax (which were marked obsolete and removed from viewport/docking branch already). + - 2019/01/06 (1.67) - renamed io.InputCharacters[], marked internal as was always intended. Please don't access directly, and use AddInputCharacter() instead! + - 2019/01/06 (1.67) - renamed ImFontAtlas::GlyphRangesBuilder to ImFontGlyphRangesBuilder. Kept redirection typedef (will obsolete). + - 2018/12/20 (1.67) - made it illegal to call Begin("") with an empty string. This somehow half-worked before but had various undesirable side-effects. + - 2018/12/10 (1.67) - renamed io.ConfigResizeWindowsFromEdges to io.ConfigWindowsResizeFromEdges as we are doing a large pass on configuration flags. + - 2018/10/12 (1.66) - renamed misc/stl/imgui_stl.* to misc/cpp/imgui_stdlib.* in prevision for other C++ helper files. + - 2018/09/28 (1.66) - renamed SetScrollHere() to SetScrollHereY(). Kept redirection function (will obsolete). + - 2018/09/06 (1.65) - renamed stb_truetype.h to imstb_truetype.h, stb_textedit.h to imstb_textedit.h, and stb_rect_pack.h to imstb_rectpack.h. + If you were conveniently using the imgui copy of those STB headers in your project you will have to update your include paths. + - 2018/09/05 (1.65) - renamed io.OptCursorBlink/io.ConfigCursorBlink to io.ConfigInputTextCursorBlink. (#1427) + - 2018/08/31 (1.64) - added imgui_widgets.cpp file, extracted and moved widgets code out of imgui.cpp into imgui_widgets.cpp. Re-ordered some of the code remaining in imgui.cpp. + NONE OF THE FUNCTIONS HAVE CHANGED. THE CODE IS SEMANTICALLY 100% IDENTICAL, BUT _EVERY_ FUNCTION HAS BEEN MOVED. + Because of this, any local modifications to imgui.cpp will likely conflict when you update. Read docs/CHANGELOG.txt for suggestions. + - 2018/08/22 (1.63) - renamed IsItemDeactivatedAfterChange() to IsItemDeactivatedAfterEdit() for consistency with new IsItemEdited() API. Kept redirection function (will obsolete soonish as IsItemDeactivatedAfterChange() is very recent). + - 2018/08/21 (1.63) - renamed ImGuiTextEditCallback to ImGuiInputTextCallback, ImGuiTextEditCallbackData to ImGuiInputTextCallbackData for consistency. Kept redirection types (will obsolete). + - 2018/08/21 (1.63) - removed ImGuiInputTextCallbackData::ReadOnly since it is a duplication of (ImGuiInputTextCallbackData::Flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_ReadOnly). + - 2018/08/01 (1.63) - removed per-window ImGuiWindowFlags_ResizeFromAnySide beta flag in favor of a global io.ConfigResizeWindowsFromEdges [update 1.67 renamed to ConfigWindowsResizeFromEdges] to enable the feature. + - 2018/08/01 (1.63) - renamed io.OptCursorBlink to io.ConfigCursorBlink [-> io.ConfigInputTextCursorBlink in 1.65], io.OptMacOSXBehaviors to ConfigMacOSXBehaviors for consistency. + - 2018/07/22 (1.63) - changed ImGui::GetTime() return value from float to double to avoid accumulating floating point imprecisions over time. + - 2018/07/08 (1.63) - style: renamed ImGuiCol_ModalWindowDarkening to ImGuiCol_ModalWindowDimBg for consistency with other features. Kept redirection enum (will obsolete). + - 2018/06/08 (1.62) - examples: the imgui_impl_XXX files have been split to separate platform (Win32, GLFW, SDL2, etc.) from renderer (DX11, OpenGL, Vulkan, etc.). + old backends will still work as is, however prefer using the separated backends as they will be updated to support multi-viewports. + when adopting new backends follow the main.cpp code of your preferred examples/ folder to know which functions to call. + in particular, note that old backends called ImGui::NewFrame() at the end of their ImGui_ImplXXXX_NewFrame() function. + - 2018/06/06 (1.62) - renamed GetGlyphRangesChinese() to GetGlyphRangesChineseFull() to distinguish other variants and discourage using the full set. + - 2018/06/06 (1.62) - TreeNodeEx()/TreeNodeBehavior(): the ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_CollapsingHeader helper now include the ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NoTreePushOnOpen flag. See Changelog for details. + - 2018/05/03 (1.61) - DragInt(): the default compile-time format string has been changed from "%.0f" to "%d", as we are not using integers internally any more. + If you used DragInt() with custom format strings, make sure you change them to use %d or an integer-compatible format. + To honor backward-compatibility, the DragInt() code will currently parse and modify format strings to replace %*f with %d, giving time to users to upgrade their code. + If you have IMGUI_DISABLE_OBSOLETE_FUNCTIONS enabled, the code will instead assert! You may run a reg-exp search on your codebase for e.g. "DragInt.*%f" to help you find them. + - 2018/04/28 (1.61) - obsoleted InputFloat() functions taking an optional "int decimal_precision" in favor of an equivalent and more flexible "const char* format", + consistent with other functions. Kept redirection functions (will obsolete). + - 2018/04/09 (1.61) - IM_DELETE() helper function added in 1.60 doesn't clear the input _pointer_ reference, more consistent with expectation and allows passing r-value. + - 2018/03/20 (1.60) - renamed io.WantMoveMouse to io.WantSetMousePos for consistency and ease of understanding (was added in 1.52, _not_ used by core and only honored by some backend ahead of merging the Nav branch). + - 2018/03/12 (1.60) - removed ImGuiCol_CloseButton, ImGuiCol_CloseButtonActive, ImGuiCol_CloseButtonHovered as the closing cross uses regular button colors now. + - 2018/03/08 (1.60) - changed ImFont::DisplayOffset.y to default to 0 instead of +1. Fixed rounding of Ascent/Descent to match TrueType renderer. If you were adding or subtracting to ImFont::DisplayOffset check if your fonts are correctly aligned vertically. + - 2018/03/03 (1.60) - renamed ImGuiStyleVar_Count_ to ImGuiStyleVar_COUNT and ImGuiMouseCursor_Count_ to ImGuiMouseCursor_COUNT for consistency with other public enums. + - 2018/02/18 (1.60) - BeginDragDropSource(): temporarily removed the optional mouse_button=0 parameter because it is not really usable in many situations at the moment. + - 2018/02/16 (1.60) - obsoleted the io.RenderDrawListsFn callback, you can call your graphics engine render function after ImGui::Render(). Use ImGui::GetDrawData() to retrieve the ImDrawData* to display. + - 2018/02/07 (1.60) - reorganized context handling to be more explicit, + - YOU NOW NEED TO CALL ImGui::CreateContext() AT THE BEGINNING OF YOUR APP, AND CALL ImGui::DestroyContext() AT THE END. + - removed Shutdown() function, as DestroyContext() serve this purpose. + - you may pass a ImFontAtlas* pointer to CreateContext() to share a font atlas between contexts. Otherwise CreateContext() will create its own font atlas instance. + - removed allocator parameters from CreateContext(), they are now setup with SetAllocatorFunctions(), and shared by all contexts. + - removed the default global context and font atlas instance, which were confusing for users of DLL reloading and users of multiple contexts. + - 2018/01/31 (1.60) - moved sample TTF files from extra_fonts/ to misc/fonts/. If you loaded files directly from the imgui repo you may need to update your paths. + - 2018/01/11 (1.60) - obsoleted IsAnyWindowHovered() in favor of IsWindowHovered(ImGuiHoveredFlags_AnyWindow). Kept redirection function (will obsolete). + - 2018/01/11 (1.60) - obsoleted IsAnyWindowFocused() in favor of IsWindowFocused(ImGuiFocusedFlags_AnyWindow). Kept redirection function (will obsolete). + - 2018/01/03 (1.60) - renamed ImGuiSizeConstraintCallback to ImGuiSizeCallback, ImGuiSizeConstraintCallbackData to ImGuiSizeCallbackData. + - 2017/12/29 (1.60) - removed CalcItemRectClosestPoint() which was weird and not really used by anyone except demo code. If you need it it's easy to replicate on your side. + - 2017/12/24 (1.53) - renamed the emblematic ShowTestWindow() function to ShowDemoWindow(). Kept redirection function (will obsolete). + - 2017/12/21 (1.53) - ImDrawList: renamed style.AntiAliasedShapes to style.AntiAliasedFill for consistency and as a way to explicitly break code that manipulate those flag at runtime. You can now manipulate ImDrawList::Flags + - 2017/12/21 (1.53) - ImDrawList: removed 'bool anti_aliased = true' final parameter of ImDrawList::AddPolyline() and ImDrawList::AddConvexPolyFilled(). Prefer manipulating ImDrawList::Flags if you need to toggle them during the frame. + - 2017/12/14 (1.53) - using the ImGuiWindowFlags_NoScrollWithMouse flag on a child window forwards the mouse wheel event to the parent window, unless either ImGuiWindowFlags_NoInputs or ImGuiWindowFlags_NoScrollbar are also set. + - 2017/12/13 (1.53) - renamed GetItemsLineHeightWithSpacing() to GetFrameHeightWithSpacing(). Kept redirection function (will obsolete). + - 2017/12/13 (1.53) - obsoleted IsRootWindowFocused() in favor of using IsWindowFocused(ImGuiFocusedFlags_RootWindow). Kept redirection function (will obsolete). + - obsoleted IsRootWindowOrAnyChildFocused() in favor of using IsWindowFocused(ImGuiFocusedFlags_RootAndChildWindows). Kept redirection function (will obsolete). + - 2017/12/12 (1.53) - renamed ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_AllowOverlapMode to ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_AllowItemOverlap. Kept redirection enum (will obsolete). + - 2017/12/10 (1.53) - removed SetNextWindowContentWidth(), prefer using SetNextWindowContentSize(). Kept redirection function (will obsolete). + - 2017/11/27 (1.53) - renamed ImGuiTextBuffer::append() helper to appendf(), appendv() to appendfv(). If you copied the 'Log' demo in your code, it uses appendv() so that needs to be renamed. + - 2017/11/18 (1.53) - Style, Begin: removed ImGuiWindowFlags_ShowBorders window flag. Borders are now fully set up in the ImGuiStyle structure (see e.g. style.FrameBorderSize, style.WindowBorderSize). Use ImGui::ShowStyleEditor() to look them up. + Please note that the style system will keep evolving (hopefully stabilizing in Q1 2018), and so custom styles will probably subtly break over time. It is recommended you use the StyleColorsClassic(), StyleColorsDark(), StyleColorsLight() functions. + - 2017/11/18 (1.53) - Style: removed ImGuiCol_ComboBg in favor of combo boxes using ImGuiCol_PopupBg for consistency. + - 2017/11/18 (1.53) - Style: renamed ImGuiCol_ChildWindowBg to ImGuiCol_ChildBg. + - 2017/11/18 (1.53) - Style: renamed style.ChildWindowRounding to style.ChildRounding, ImGuiStyleVar_ChildWindowRounding to ImGuiStyleVar_ChildRounding. + - 2017/11/02 (1.53) - obsoleted IsRootWindowOrAnyChildHovered() in favor of using IsWindowHovered(ImGuiHoveredFlags_RootAndChildWindows); + - 2017/10/24 (1.52) - renamed IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_DEFAULT_CLIPBOARD_FUNCS/IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_DEFAULT_IME_FUNCS to IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_DEFAULT_CLIPBOARD_FUNCTIONS/IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_DEFAULT_IME_FUNCTIONS for consistency. + - 2017/10/20 (1.52) - changed IsWindowHovered() default parameters behavior to return false if an item is active in another window (e.g. click-dragging item from another window to this window). You can use the newly introduced IsWindowHovered() flags to requests this specific behavior if you need it. + - 2017/10/20 (1.52) - marked IsItemHoveredRect()/IsMouseHoveringWindow() as obsolete, in favor of using the newly introduced flags for IsItemHovered() and IsWindowHovered(). See https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/issues/1382 for details. + removed the IsItemRectHovered()/IsWindowRectHovered() names introduced in 1.51 since they were merely more consistent names for the two functions we are now obsoleting. + IsItemHoveredRect() --> IsItemHovered(ImGuiHoveredFlags_RectOnly) + IsMouseHoveringAnyWindow() --> IsWindowHovered(ImGuiHoveredFlags_AnyWindow) + IsMouseHoveringWindow() --> IsWindowHovered(ImGuiHoveredFlags_AllowWhenBlockedByPopup | ImGuiHoveredFlags_AllowWhenBlockedByActiveItem) [weird, old behavior] + - 2017/10/17 (1.52) - marked the old 5-parameters version of Begin() as obsolete (still available). Use SetNextWindowSize()+Begin() instead! + - 2017/10/11 (1.52) - renamed AlignFirstTextHeightToWidgets() to AlignTextToFramePadding(). Kept inline redirection function (will obsolete). + - 2017/09/26 (1.52) - renamed ImFont::Glyph to ImFontGlyph. Kept redirection typedef (will obsolete). + - 2017/09/25 (1.52) - removed SetNextWindowPosCenter() because SetNextWindowPos() now has the optional pivot information to do the same and more. Kept redirection function (will obsolete). + - 2017/08/25 (1.52) - io.MousePos needs to be set to ImVec2(-FLT_MAX,-FLT_MAX) when mouse is unavailable/missing. Previously ImVec2(-1,-1) was enough but we now accept negative mouse coordinates. In your backend if you need to support unavailable mouse, make sure to replace "io.MousePos = ImVec2(-1,-1)" with "io.MousePos = ImVec2(-FLT_MAX,-FLT_MAX)". + - 2017/08/22 (1.51) - renamed IsItemHoveredRect() to IsItemRectHovered(). Kept inline redirection function (will obsolete). -> (1.52) use IsItemHovered(ImGuiHoveredFlags_RectOnly)! + - renamed IsMouseHoveringAnyWindow() to IsAnyWindowHovered() for consistency. Kept inline redirection function (will obsolete). + - renamed IsMouseHoveringWindow() to IsWindowRectHovered() for consistency. Kept inline redirection function (will obsolete). + - 2017/08/20 (1.51) - renamed GetStyleColName() to GetStyleColorName() for consistency. + - 2017/08/20 (1.51) - added PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol idx, ImU32 col) overload, which _might_ cause an "ambiguous call" compilation error if you are using ImColor() with implicit cast. Cast to ImU32 or ImVec4 explicily to fix. + - 2017/08/15 (1.51) - marked the weird IMGUI_ONCE_UPON_A_FRAME helper macro as obsolete. prefer using the more explicit ImGuiOnceUponAFrame type. + - 2017/08/15 (1.51) - changed parameter order for BeginPopupContextWindow() from (const char*,int buttons,bool also_over_items) to (const char*,int buttons,bool also_over_items). Note that most calls relied on default parameters completely. + - 2017/08/13 (1.51) - renamed ImGuiCol_Column to ImGuiCol_Separator, ImGuiCol_ColumnHovered to ImGuiCol_SeparatorHovered, ImGuiCol_ColumnActive to ImGuiCol_SeparatorActive. Kept redirection enums (will obsolete). + - 2017/08/11 (1.51) - renamed ImGuiSetCond_Always to ImGuiCond_Always, ImGuiSetCond_Once to ImGuiCond_Once, ImGuiSetCond_FirstUseEver to ImGuiCond_FirstUseEver, ImGuiSetCond_Appearing to ImGuiCond_Appearing. Kept redirection enums (will obsolete). + - 2017/08/09 (1.51) - removed ValueColor() helpers, they are equivalent to calling Text(label) + SameLine() + ColorButton(). + - 2017/08/08 (1.51) - removed ColorEditMode() and ImGuiColorEditMode in favor of ImGuiColorEditFlags and parameters to the various Color*() functions. The SetColorEditOptions() allows to initialize default but the user can still change them with right-click context menu. + - changed prototype of 'ColorEdit4(const char* label, float col[4], bool show_alpha = true)' to 'ColorEdit4(const char* label, float col[4], ImGuiColorEditFlags flags = 0)', where passing flags = 0x01 is a safe no-op (hello dodgy backward compatibility!). - check and run the demo window, under "Color/Picker Widgets", to understand the various new options. + - changed prototype of rarely used 'ColorButton(ImVec4 col, bool small_height = false, bool outline_border = true)' to 'ColorButton(const char* desc_id, ImVec4 col, ImGuiColorEditFlags flags = 0, ImVec2 size = ImVec2(0, 0))' + - 2017/07/20 (1.51) - removed IsPosHoveringAnyWindow(ImVec2), which was partly broken and misleading. ASSERT + redirect user to io.WantCaptureMouse + - 2017/05/26 (1.50) - removed ImFontConfig::MergeGlyphCenterV in favor of a more multipurpose ImFontConfig::GlyphOffset. + - 2017/05/01 (1.50) - renamed ImDrawList::PathFill() (rarely used directly) to ImDrawList::PathFillConvex() for clarity. + - 2016/11/06 (1.50) - BeginChild(const char*) now applies the stack id to the provided label, consistently with other functions as it should always have been. It shouldn't affect you unless (extremely unlikely) you were appending multiple times to a same child from different locations of the stack id. If that's the case, generate an id with GetID() and use it instead of passing string to BeginChild(). + - 2016/10/15 (1.50) - avoid 'void* user_data' parameter to io.SetClipboardTextFn/io.GetClipboardTextFn pointers. We pass io.ClipboardUserData to it. + - 2016/09/25 (1.50) - style.WindowTitleAlign is now a ImVec2 (ImGuiAlign enum was removed). set to (0.5f,0.5f) for horizontal+vertical centering, (0.0f,0.0f) for upper-left, etc. + - 2016/07/30 (1.50) - SameLine(x) with x>0.0f is now relative to left of column/group if any, and not always to left of window. This was sort of always the intent and hopefully, breakage should be minimal. + - 2016/05/12 (1.49) - title bar (using ImGuiCol_TitleBg/ImGuiCol_TitleBgActive colors) isn't rendered over a window background (ImGuiCol_WindowBg color) anymore. + If your TitleBg/TitleBgActive alpha was 1.0f or you are using the default theme it will not affect you, otherwise if <1.0f you need to tweak your custom theme to readjust for the fact that we don't draw a WindowBg background behind the title bar. + This helper function will convert an old TitleBg/TitleBgActive color into a new one with the same visual output, given the OLD color and the OLD WindowBg color: + ImVec4 ConvertTitleBgCol(const ImVec4& win_bg_col, const ImVec4& title_bg_col) { float new_a = 1.0f - ((1.0f - win_bg_col.w) * (1.0f - title_bg_col.w)), k = title_bg_col.w / new_a; return ImVec4((win_bg_col.x * win_bg_col.w + title_bg_col.x) * k, (win_bg_col.y * win_bg_col.w + title_bg_col.y) * k, (win_bg_col.z * win_bg_col.w + title_bg_col.z) * k, new_a); } + If this is confusing, pick the RGB value from title bar from an old screenshot and apply this as TitleBg/TitleBgActive. Or you may just create TitleBgActive from a tweaked TitleBg color. + - 2016/05/07 (1.49) - removed confusing set of GetInternalState(), GetInternalStateSize(), SetInternalState() functions. Now using CreateContext(), DestroyContext(), GetCurrentContext(), SetCurrentContext(). + - 2016/05/02 (1.49) - renamed SetNextTreeNodeOpened() to SetNextTreeNodeOpen(), no redirection. + - 2016/05/01 (1.49) - obsoleted old signature of CollapsingHeader(const char* label, const char* str_id = NULL, bool display_frame = true, bool default_open = false) as extra parameters were badly designed and rarely used. You can replace the "default_open = true" flag in new API with CollapsingHeader(label, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_DefaultOpen). + - 2016/04/26 (1.49) - changed ImDrawList::PushClipRect(ImVec4 rect) to ImDrawList::PushClipRect(Imvec2 min,ImVec2 max,bool intersect_with_current_clip_rect=false). Note that higher-level ImGui::PushClipRect() is preferable because it will clip at logic/widget level, whereas ImDrawList::PushClipRect() only affect your renderer. + - 2016/04/03 (1.48) - removed style.WindowFillAlphaDefault setting which was redundant. Bake default BG alpha inside style.Colors[ImGuiCol_WindowBg] and all other Bg color values. (ref GitHub issue #337). + - 2016/04/03 (1.48) - renamed ImGuiCol_TooltipBg to ImGuiCol_PopupBg, used by popups/menus and tooltips. popups/menus were previously using ImGuiCol_WindowBg. (ref github issue #337) + - 2016/03/21 (1.48) - renamed GetWindowFont() to GetFont(), GetWindowFontSize() to GetFontSize(). Kept inline redirection function (will obsolete). + - 2016/03/02 (1.48) - InputText() completion/history/always callbacks: if you modify the text buffer manually (without using DeleteChars()/InsertChars() helper) you need to maintain the BufTextLen field. added an assert. + - 2016/01/23 (1.48) - fixed not honoring exact width passed to PushItemWidth(), previously it would add extra FramePadding.x*2 over that width. if you had manual pixel-perfect alignment in place it might affect you. + - 2015/12/27 (1.48) - fixed ImDrawList::AddRect() which used to render a rectangle 1 px too large on each axis. + - 2015/12/04 (1.47) - renamed Color() helpers to ValueColor() - dangerously named, rarely used and probably to be made obsolete. + - 2015/08/29 (1.45) - with the addition of horizontal scrollbar we made various fixes to inconsistencies with dealing with cursor position. + GetCursorPos()/SetCursorPos() functions now include the scrolled amount. It shouldn't affect the majority of users, but take note that SetCursorPosX(100.0f) puts you at +100 from the starting x position which may include scrolling, not at +100 from the window left side. + GetContentRegionMax()/GetWindowContentRegionMin()/GetWindowContentRegionMax() functions allow include the scrolled amount. Typically those were used in cases where no scrolling would happen so it may not be a problem, but watch out! + - 2015/08/29 (1.45) - renamed style.ScrollbarWidth to style.ScrollbarSize + - 2015/08/05 (1.44) - split imgui.cpp into extra files: imgui_demo.cpp imgui_draw.cpp imgui_internal.h that you need to add to your project. + - 2015/07/18 (1.44) - fixed angles in ImDrawList::PathArcTo(), PathArcToFast() (introduced in 1.43) being off by an extra PI for no justifiable reason + - 2015/07/14 (1.43) - add new ImFontAtlas::AddFont() API. For the old AddFont***, moved the 'font_no' parameter of ImFontAtlas::AddFont** functions to the ImFontConfig structure. + you need to render your textured triangles with bilinear filtering to benefit from sub-pixel positioning of text. + - 2015/07/08 (1.43) - switched rendering data to use indexed rendering. this is saving a fair amount of CPU/GPU and enables us to get anti-aliasing for a marginal cost. + this necessary change will break your rendering function! the fix should be very easy. sorry for that :( + - if you are using a vanilla copy of one of the imgui_impl_XXX.cpp provided in the example, you just need to update your copy and you can ignore the rest. + - the signature of the io.RenderDrawListsFn handler has changed! + old: ImGui_XXXX_RenderDrawLists(ImDrawList** const cmd_lists, int cmd_lists_count) + new: ImGui_XXXX_RenderDrawLists(ImDrawData* draw_data). + parameters: 'cmd_lists' becomes 'draw_data->CmdLists', 'cmd_lists_count' becomes 'draw_data->CmdListsCount' + ImDrawList: 'commands' becomes 'CmdBuffer', 'vtx_buffer' becomes 'VtxBuffer', 'IdxBuffer' is new. + ImDrawCmd: 'vtx_count' becomes 'ElemCount', 'clip_rect' becomes 'ClipRect', 'user_callback' becomes 'UserCallback', 'texture_id' becomes 'TextureId'. + - each ImDrawList now contains both a vertex buffer and an index buffer. For each command, render ElemCount/3 triangles using indices from the index buffer. + - if you REALLY cannot render indexed primitives, you can call the draw_data->DeIndexAllBuffers() method to de-index the buffers. This is slow and a waste of CPU/GPU. Prefer using indexed rendering! + - refer to code in the examples/ folder or ask on the GitHub if you are unsure of how to upgrade. please upgrade! + - 2015/07/10 (1.43) - changed SameLine() parameters from int to float. + - 2015/07/02 (1.42) - renamed SetScrollPosHere() to SetScrollFromCursorPos(). Kept inline redirection function (will obsolete). + - 2015/07/02 (1.42) - renamed GetScrollPosY() to GetScrollY(). Necessary to reduce confusion along with other scrolling functions, because positions (e.g. cursor position) are not equivalent to scrolling amount. + - 2015/06/14 (1.41) - changed ImageButton() default bg_col parameter from (0,0,0,1) (black) to (0,0,0,0) (transparent) - makes a difference when texture have transparence + - 2015/06/14 (1.41) - changed Selectable() API from (label, selected, size) to (label, selected, flags, size). Size override should have been rarely used. Sorry! + - 2015/05/31 (1.40) - renamed GetWindowCollapsed() to IsWindowCollapsed() for consistency. Kept inline redirection function (will obsolete). + - 2015/05/31 (1.40) - renamed IsRectClipped() to IsRectVisible() for consistency. Note that return value is opposite! Kept inline redirection function (will obsolete). + - 2015/05/27 (1.40) - removed the third 'repeat_if_held' parameter from Button() - sorry! it was rarely used and inconsistent. Use PushButtonRepeat(true) / PopButtonRepeat() to enable repeat on desired buttons. + - 2015/05/11 (1.40) - changed BeginPopup() API, takes a string identifier instead of a bool. ImGui needs to manage the open/closed state of popups. Call OpenPopup() to actually set the "open" state of a popup. BeginPopup() returns true if the popup is opened. + - 2015/05/03 (1.40) - removed style.AutoFitPadding, using style.WindowPadding makes more sense (the default values were already the same). + - 2015/04/13 (1.38) - renamed IsClipped() to IsRectClipped(). Kept inline redirection function until 1.50. + - 2015/04/09 (1.38) - renamed ImDrawList::AddArc() to ImDrawList::AddArcFast() for compatibility with future API + - 2015/04/03 (1.38) - removed ImGuiCol_CheckHovered, ImGuiCol_CheckActive, replaced with the more general ImGuiCol_FrameBgHovered, ImGuiCol_FrameBgActive. + - 2014/04/03 (1.38) - removed support for passing -FLT_MAX..+FLT_MAX as the range for a SliderFloat(). Use DragFloat() or Inputfloat() instead. + - 2015/03/17 (1.36) - renamed GetItemBoxMin()/GetItemBoxMax()/IsMouseHoveringBox() to GetItemRectMin()/GetItemRectMax()/IsMouseHoveringRect(). Kept inline redirection function until 1.50. + - 2015/03/15 (1.36) - renamed style.TreeNodeSpacing to style.IndentSpacing, ImGuiStyleVar_TreeNodeSpacing to ImGuiStyleVar_IndentSpacing + - 2015/03/13 (1.36) - renamed GetWindowIsFocused() to IsWindowFocused(). Kept inline redirection function until 1.50. + - 2015/03/08 (1.35) - renamed style.ScrollBarWidth to style.ScrollbarWidth (casing) + - 2015/02/27 (1.34) - renamed OpenNextNode(bool) to SetNextTreeNodeOpened(bool, ImGuiSetCond). Kept inline redirection function until 1.50. + - 2015/02/27 (1.34) - renamed ImGuiSetCondition_*** to ImGuiSetCond_***, and _FirstUseThisSession becomes _Once. + - 2015/02/11 (1.32) - changed text input callback ImGuiTextEditCallback return type from void-->int. reserved for future use, return 0 for now. + - 2015/02/10 (1.32) - renamed GetItemWidth() to CalcItemWidth() to clarify its evolving behavior + - 2015/02/08 (1.31) - renamed GetTextLineSpacing() to GetTextLineHeightWithSpacing() + - 2015/02/01 (1.31) - removed IO.MemReallocFn (unused) + - 2015/01/19 (1.30) - renamed ImGuiStorage::GetIntPtr()/GetFloatPtr() to GetIntRef()/GetIntRef() because Ptr was conflicting with actual pointer storage functions. + - 2015/01/11 (1.30) - big font/image API change! now loads TTF file. allow for multiple fonts. no need for a PNG loader. + - 2015/01/11 (1.30) - removed GetDefaultFontData(). uses io.Fonts->GetTextureData*() API to retrieve uncompressed pixels. + - old: const void* png_data; unsigned int png_size; ImGui::GetDefaultFontData(NULL, NULL, &png_data, &png_size); [..Upload texture to GPU..]; + - new: unsigned char* pixels; int width, height; io.Fonts->GetTexDataAsRGBA32(&pixels, &width, &height); [..Upload texture to GPU..]; io.Fonts->SetTexID(YourTexIdentifier); + you now have more flexibility to load multiple TTF fonts and manage the texture buffer for internal needs. It is now recommended that you sample the font texture with bilinear interpolation. + - 2015/01/11 (1.30) - added texture identifier in ImDrawCmd passed to your render function (we can now render images). make sure to call io.Fonts->SetTexID() + - 2015/01/11 (1.30) - removed IO.PixelCenterOffset (unnecessary, can be handled in user projection matrix) + - 2015/01/11 (1.30) - removed ImGui::IsItemFocused() in favor of ImGui::IsItemActive() which handles all widgets + - 2014/12/10 (1.18) - removed SetNewWindowDefaultPos() in favor of new generic API SetNextWindowPos(pos, ImGuiSetCondition_FirstUseEver) + - 2014/11/28 (1.17) - moved IO.Font*** options to inside the IO.Font-> structure (FontYOffset, FontTexUvForWhite, FontBaseScale, FontFallbackGlyph) + - 2014/11/26 (1.17) - reworked syntax of IMGUI_ONCE_UPON_A_FRAME helper macro to increase compiler compatibility + - 2014/11/07 (1.15) - renamed IsHovered() to IsItemHovered() + - 2014/10/02 (1.14) - renamed IMGUI_INCLUDE_IMGUI_USER_CPP to IMGUI_INCLUDE_IMGUI_USER_INL and imgui_user.cpp to imgui_user.inl (more IDE friendly) + - 2014/09/25 (1.13) - removed 'text_end' parameter from IO.SetClipboardTextFn (the string is now always zero-terminated for simplicity) + - 2014/09/24 (1.12) - renamed SetFontScale() to SetWindowFontScale() + - 2014/09/24 (1.12) - moved IM_MALLOC/IM_REALLOC/IM_FREE preprocessor defines to IO.MemAllocFn/IO.MemReallocFn/IO.MemFreeFn + - 2014/08/30 (1.09) - removed IO.FontHeight (now computed automatically) + - 2014/08/30 (1.09) - moved IMGUI_FONT_TEX_UV_FOR_WHITE preprocessor define to IO.FontTexUvForWhite + - 2014/08/28 (1.09) - changed the behavior of IO.PixelCenterOffset following various rendering fixes + + + FREQUENTLY ASKED QUESTIONS (FAQ) + ================================ + + Read all answers online: + https://www.dearimgui.org/faq or https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/blob/master/docs/FAQ.md (same url) + Read all answers locally (with a text editor or ideally a Markdown viewer): + docs/FAQ.md + Some answers are copied down here to facilitate searching in code. + + Q&A: Basics + =========== + + Q: Where is the documentation? + A: This library is poorly documented at the moment and expects the user to be acquainted with C/C++. + - Run the examples/ and explore them. + - See demo code in imgui_demo.cpp and particularly the ImGui::ShowDemoWindow() function. + - The demo covers most features of Dear ImGui, so you can read the code and see its output. + - See documentation and comments at the top of imgui.cpp + effectively imgui.h. + - Dozens of standalone example applications using e.g. OpenGL/DirectX are provided in the + examples/ folder to explain how to integrate Dear ImGui with your own engine/application. + - The Wiki (https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/wiki) has many resources and links. + - The Glossary (https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/wiki/Glossary) page also may be useful. + - Your programming IDE is your friend, find the type or function declaration to find comments + associated with it. + + Q: What is this library called? + Q: Which version should I get? + >> This library is called "Dear ImGui", please don't call it "ImGui" :) + >> See https://www.dearimgui.org/faq for details. + + Q&A: Integration + ================ + + Q: How to get started? + A: Read 'PROGRAMMER GUIDE' above. Read examples/README.txt. + + Q: How can I tell whether to dispatch mouse/keyboard to Dear ImGui or my application? + A: You should read the 'io.WantCaptureMouse', 'io.WantCaptureKeyboard' and 'io.WantTextInput' flags! + >> See https://www.dearimgui.org/faq for a fully detailed answer. You really want to read this. + + Q. How can I enable keyboard controls? + Q: How can I use this without a mouse, without a keyboard or without a screen? (gamepad, input share, remote display) + Q: I integrated Dear ImGui in my engine and little squares are showing instead of text... + Q: I integrated Dear ImGui in my engine and some elements are clipping or disappearing when I move windows around... + Q: I integrated Dear ImGui in my engine and some elements are displaying outside their expected windows boundaries... + >> See https://www.dearimgui.org/faq + + Q&A: Usage + ---------- + + Q: Why is my widget not reacting when I click on it? + Q: How can I have widgets with an empty label? + Q: How can I have multiple widgets with the same label? + Q: How can I display an image? What is ImTextureID, how does it works? + Q: How can I use my own math types instead of ImVec2/ImVec4? + Q: How can I interact with standard C++ types (such as std::string and std::vector)? + Q: How can I display custom shapes? (using low-level ImDrawList API) + >> See https://www.dearimgui.org/faq + + Q&A: Fonts, Text + ================ + + Q: How should I handle DPI in my application? + Q: How can I load a different font than the default? + Q: How can I easily use icons in my application? + Q: How can I load multiple fonts? + Q: How can I display and input non-Latin characters such as Chinese, Japanese, Korean, Cyrillic? + >> See https://www.dearimgui.org/faq and https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/edit/master/docs/FONTS.md + + Q&A: Concerns + ============= + + Q: Who uses Dear ImGui? + Q: Can you create elaborate/serious tools with Dear ImGui? + Q: Can you reskin the look of Dear ImGui? + Q: Why using C++ (as opposed to C)? + >> See https://www.dearimgui.org/faq + + Q&A: Community + ============== + + Q: How can I help? + A: - Businesses: please reach out to "contact AT dearimgui.com" if you work in a place using Dear ImGui! + We can discuss ways for your company to fund development via invoiced technical support, maintenance or sponsoring contacts. + This is among the most useful thing you can do for Dear ImGui. With increased funding, we can hire more people working on this project. + - Individuals: you can support continued development via PayPal donations. See README. + - If you are experienced with Dear ImGui and C++, look at the GitHub issues, look at the Wiki, read docs/TODO.txt + and see how you want to help and can help! + - Disclose your usage of Dear ImGui via a dev blog post, a tweet, a screenshot, a mention somewhere etc. + You may post screenshot or links in the gallery threads. Visuals are ideal as they inspire other programmers. + But even without visuals, disclosing your use of dear imgui helps the library grow credibility, and help other teams and programmers with taking decisions. + - If you have issues or if you need to hack into the library, even if you don't expect any support it is useful that you share your issues (on GitHub or privately). + +*/ + +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] INCLUDES +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +#if defined(_MSC_VER) && !defined(_CRT_SECURE_NO_WARNINGS) +#define _CRT_SECURE_NO_WARNINGS +#endif + +#include "imgui.h" +#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE + +#ifndef IMGUI_DEFINE_MATH_OPERATORS +#define IMGUI_DEFINE_MATH_OPERATORS +#endif +#include "imgui_internal.h" + +// System includes +#include // toupper +#include // vsnprintf, sscanf, printf +#if defined(_MSC_VER) && _MSC_VER <= 1500 // MSVC 2008 or earlier +#include // intptr_t +#else +#include // intptr_t +#endif + +// [Windows] On non-Visual Studio compilers, we default to IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_DEFAULT_IME_FUNCTIONS unless explicitly enabled +#if defined(_WIN32) && !defined(_MSC_VER) && !defined(IMGUI_ENABLE_WIN32_DEFAULT_IME_FUNCTIONS) && !defined(IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_DEFAULT_IME_FUNCTIONS) +#define IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_DEFAULT_IME_FUNCTIONS +#endif + +// [Windows] OS specific includes (optional) +#if defined(_WIN32) && defined(IMGUI_DISABLE_DEFAULT_FILE_FUNCTIONS) && defined(IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_DEFAULT_CLIPBOARD_FUNCTIONS) && defined(IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_DEFAULT_IME_FUNCTIONS) && !defined(IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_FUNCTIONS) +#define IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_FUNCTIONS +#endif +#if defined(_WIN32) && !defined(IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_FUNCTIONS) +#ifndef WIN32_LEAN_AND_MEAN +#define WIN32_LEAN_AND_MEAN +#endif +#ifndef NOMINMAX +#define NOMINMAX +#endif +#ifndef __MINGW32__ +#include // _wfopen, OpenClipboard +#else +#include +#endif +#if defined(WINAPI_FAMILY) && (WINAPI_FAMILY == WINAPI_FAMILY_APP) // UWP doesn't have all Win32 functions +#define IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_DEFAULT_CLIPBOARD_FUNCTIONS +#define IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_DEFAULT_IME_FUNCTIONS +#endif +#endif + +// [Apple] OS specific includes +#if defined(__APPLE__) +#include +#endif + +// Visual Studio warnings +#ifdef _MSC_VER +#pragma warning (disable: 4127) // condition expression is constant +#pragma warning (disable: 4996) // 'This function or variable may be unsafe': strcpy, strdup, sprintf, vsnprintf, sscanf, fopen +#if defined(_MSC_VER) && _MSC_VER >= 1922 // MSVC 2019 16.2 or later +#pragma warning (disable: 5054) // operator '|': deprecated between enumerations of different types +#endif +#pragma warning (disable: 26451) // [Static Analyzer] Arithmetic overflow : Using operator 'xxx' on a 4 byte value and then casting the result to a 8 byte value. Cast the value to the wider type before calling operator 'xxx' to avoid overflow(io.2). +#pragma warning (disable: 26495) // [Static Analyzer] Variable 'XXX' is uninitialized. Always initialize a member variable (type.6). +#pragma warning (disable: 26812) // [Static Analyzer] The enum type 'xxx' is unscoped. Prefer 'enum class' over 'enum' (Enum.3). +#endif + +// Clang/GCC warnings with -Weverything +#if defined(__clang__) +#if __has_warning("-Wunknown-warning-option") +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wunknown-warning-option" // warning: unknown warning group 'xxx' // not all warnings are known by all Clang versions and they tend to be rename-happy.. so ignoring warnings triggers new warnings on some configuration. Great! +#endif +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wunknown-pragmas" // warning: unknown warning group 'xxx' +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wold-style-cast" // warning: use of old-style cast // yes, they are more terse. +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wfloat-equal" // warning: comparing floating point with == or != is unsafe // storing and comparing against same constants (typically 0.0f) is ok. +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wformat-nonliteral" // warning: format string is not a string literal // passing non-literal to vsnformat(). yes, user passing incorrect format strings can crash the code. +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wexit-time-destructors" // warning: declaration requires an exit-time destructor // exit-time destruction order is undefined. if MemFree() leads to users code that has been disabled before exit it might cause problems. ImGui coding style welcomes static/globals. +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wglobal-constructors" // warning: declaration requires a global destructor // similar to above, not sure what the exact difference is. +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wsign-conversion" // warning: implicit conversion changes signedness +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wformat-pedantic" // warning: format specifies type 'void *' but the argument has type 'xxxx *' // unreasonable, would lead to casting every %p arg to void*. probably enabled by -pedantic. +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wint-to-void-pointer-cast" // warning: cast to 'void *' from smaller integer type 'int' +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wzero-as-null-pointer-constant" // warning: zero as null pointer constant // some standard header variations use #define NULL 0 +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wdouble-promotion" // warning: implicit conversion from 'float' to 'double' when passing argument to function // using printf() is a misery with this as C++ va_arg ellipsis changes float to double. +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wimplicit-int-float-conversion" // warning: implicit conversion from 'xxx' to 'float' may lose precision +#elif defined(__GNUC__) +// We disable -Wpragmas because GCC doesn't provide an has_warning equivalent and some forks/patches may not following the warning/version association. +#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wpragmas" // warning: unknown option after '#pragma GCC diagnostic' kind +#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wunused-function" // warning: 'xxxx' defined but not used +#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wint-to-pointer-cast" // warning: cast to pointer from integer of different size +#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wformat" // warning: format '%p' expects argument of type 'void*', but argument 6 has type 'ImGuiWindow*' +#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wdouble-promotion" // warning: implicit conversion from 'float' to 'double' when passing argument to function +#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wconversion" // warning: conversion to 'xxxx' from 'xxxx' may alter its value +#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wformat-nonliteral" // warning: format not a string literal, format string not checked +#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wstrict-overflow" // warning: assuming signed overflow does not occur when assuming that (X - c) > X is always false +#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wclass-memaccess" // [__GNUC__ >= 8] warning: 'memset/memcpy' clearing/writing an object of type 'xxxx' with no trivial copy-assignment; use assignment or value-initialization instead +#endif + +// Debug options +#define IMGUI_DEBUG_NAV_SCORING 0 // Display navigation scoring preview when hovering items. Display last moving direction matches when holding CTRL +#define IMGUI_DEBUG_NAV_RECTS 0 // Display the reference navigation rectangle for each window +#define IMGUI_DEBUG_INI_SETTINGS 0 // Save additional comments in .ini file (particularly helps for Docking, but makes saving slower) + +// When using CTRL+TAB (or Gamepad Square+L/R) we delay the visual a little in order to reduce visual noise doing a fast switch. +static const float NAV_WINDOWING_HIGHLIGHT_DELAY = 0.20f; // Time before the highlight and screen dimming starts fading in +static const float NAV_WINDOWING_LIST_APPEAR_DELAY = 0.15f; // Time before the window list starts to appear + +// Window resizing from edges (when io.ConfigWindowsResizeFromEdges = true and ImGuiBackendFlags_HasMouseCursors is set in io.BackendFlags by backend) +static const float WINDOWS_HOVER_PADDING = 4.0f; // Extend outside window for hovering/resizing (maxxed with TouchPadding) and inside windows for borders. Affect FindHoveredWindow(). +static const float WINDOWS_RESIZE_FROM_EDGES_FEEDBACK_TIMER = 0.04f; // Reduce visual noise by only highlighting the border after a certain time. +static const float WINDOWS_MOUSE_WHEEL_SCROLL_LOCK_TIMER = 2.00f; // Lock scrolled window (so it doesn't pick child windows that are scrolling through) for a certain time, unless mouse moved. + +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] FORWARD DECLARATIONS +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +static void SetCurrentWindow(ImGuiWindow* window); +static void FindHoveredWindow(); +static ImGuiWindow* CreateNewWindow(const char* name, ImGuiWindowFlags flags); +static ImVec2 CalcNextScrollFromScrollTargetAndClamp(ImGuiWindow* window); + +static void AddDrawListToDrawData(ImVector* out_list, ImDrawList* draw_list); +static void AddWindowToSortBuffer(ImVector* out_sorted_windows, ImGuiWindow* window); + +// Settings +static void WindowSettingsHandler_ClearAll(ImGuiContext*, ImGuiSettingsHandler*); +static void* WindowSettingsHandler_ReadOpen(ImGuiContext*, ImGuiSettingsHandler*, const char* name); +static void WindowSettingsHandler_ReadLine(ImGuiContext*, ImGuiSettingsHandler*, void* entry, const char* line); +static void WindowSettingsHandler_ApplyAll(ImGuiContext*, ImGuiSettingsHandler*); +static void WindowSettingsHandler_WriteAll(ImGuiContext*, ImGuiSettingsHandler*, ImGuiTextBuffer* buf); + +// Platform Dependents default implementation for IO functions +static const char* GetClipboardTextFn_DefaultImpl(void* user_data); +static void SetClipboardTextFn_DefaultImpl(void* user_data, const char* text); +static void ImeSetInputScreenPosFn_DefaultImpl(int x, int y); + +namespace ImGui +{ +// Navigation +static void NavUpdate(); +static void NavUpdateWindowing(); +static void NavUpdateWindowingOverlay(); +static void NavUpdateMoveResult(); +static void NavUpdateInitResult(); +static float NavUpdatePageUpPageDown(); +static inline void NavUpdateAnyRequestFlag(); +static void NavEndFrame(); +static bool NavScoreItem(ImGuiNavItemData* result, ImRect cand); +static void NavApplyItemToResult(ImGuiNavItemData* result, ImGuiWindow* window, ImGuiID id, const ImRect& nav_bb_rel); +static void NavProcessItem(ImGuiWindow* window, const ImRect& nav_bb, ImGuiID id); +static ImVec2 NavCalcPreferredRefPos(); +static void NavSaveLastChildNavWindowIntoParent(ImGuiWindow* nav_window); +static ImGuiWindow* NavRestoreLastChildNavWindow(ImGuiWindow* window); +static void NavRestoreLayer(ImGuiNavLayer layer); +static int FindWindowFocusIndex(ImGuiWindow* window); + +// Error Checking +static void ErrorCheckNewFrameSanityChecks(); +static void ErrorCheckEndFrameSanityChecks(); + +// Misc +static void UpdateSettings(); +static void UpdateMouseInputs(); +static void UpdateMouseWheel(); +static void UpdateTabFocus(); +static void UpdateDebugToolItemPicker(); +static bool UpdateWindowManualResize(ImGuiWindow* window, const ImVec2& size_auto_fit, int* border_held, int resize_grip_count, ImU32 resize_grip_col[4], const ImRect& visibility_rect); +static void RenderWindowOuterBorders(ImGuiWindow* window); +static void RenderWindowDecorations(ImGuiWindow* window, const ImRect& title_bar_rect, bool title_bar_is_highlight, int resize_grip_count, const ImU32 resize_grip_col[4], float resize_grip_draw_size); +static void RenderWindowTitleBarContents(ImGuiWindow* window, const ImRect& title_bar_rect, const char* name, bool* p_open); + +// Viewports +static void UpdateViewportsNewFrame(); + +} + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] CONTEXT AND MEMORY ALLOCATORS +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// DLL users: +// - Heaps and globals are not shared across DLL boundaries! +// - You will need to call SetCurrentContext() + SetAllocatorFunctions() for each static/DLL boundary you are calling from. +// - Same applies for hot-reloading mechanisms that are reliant on reloading DLL (note that many hot-reloading mechanisms work without DLL). +// - Using Dear ImGui via a shared library is not recommended, because of function call overhead and because we don't guarantee backward nor forward ABI compatibility. +// - Confused? In a debugger: add GImGui to your watch window and notice how its value changes depending on your current location (which DLL boundary you are in). + +// Current context pointer. Implicitly used by all Dear ImGui functions. Always assumed to be != NULL. +// - ImGui::CreateContext() will automatically set this pointer if it is NULL. +// Change to a different context by calling ImGui::SetCurrentContext(). +// - Important: Dear ImGui functions are not thread-safe because of this pointer. +// If you want thread-safety to allow N threads to access N different contexts: +// - Change this variable to use thread local storage so each thread can refer to a different context, in your imconfig.h: +// struct ImGuiContext; +// extern thread_local ImGuiContext* MyImGuiTLS; +// #define GImGui MyImGuiTLS +// And then define MyImGuiTLS in one of your cpp files. Note that thread_local is a C++11 keyword, earlier C++ uses compiler-specific keyword. +// - Future development aims to make this context pointer explicit to all calls. Also read https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/issues/586 +// - If you need a finite number of contexts, you may compile and use multiple instances of the ImGui code from a different namespace. +// - DLL users: read comments above. +#ifndef GImGui +ImGuiContext* GImGui = NULL; +#endif + +// Memory Allocator functions. Use SetAllocatorFunctions() to change them. +// - You probably don't want to modify that mid-program, and if you use global/static e.g. ImVector<> instances you may need to keep them accessible during program destruction. +// - DLL users: read comments above. +#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_DEFAULT_ALLOCATORS +static void* MallocWrapper(size_t size, void* user_data) { IM_UNUSED(user_data); return malloc(size); } +static void FreeWrapper(void* ptr, void* user_data) { IM_UNUSED(user_data); free(ptr); } +#else +static void* MallocWrapper(size_t size, void* user_data) { IM_UNUSED(user_data); IM_UNUSED(size); IM_ASSERT(0); return NULL; } +static void FreeWrapper(void* ptr, void* user_data) { IM_UNUSED(user_data); IM_UNUSED(ptr); IM_ASSERT(0); } +#endif +static ImGuiMemAllocFunc GImAllocatorAllocFunc = MallocWrapper; +static ImGuiMemFreeFunc GImAllocatorFreeFunc = FreeWrapper; +static void* GImAllocatorUserData = NULL; + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] USER FACING STRUCTURES (ImGuiStyle, ImGuiIO) +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +ImGuiStyle::ImGuiStyle() +{ + Alpha = 1.0f; // Global alpha applies to everything in Dear ImGui. + DisabledAlpha = 0.60f; // Additional alpha multiplier applied by BeginDisabled(). Multiply over current value of Alpha. + WindowPadding = ImVec2(8,8); // Padding within a window + WindowRounding = 0.0f; // Radius of window corners rounding. Set to 0.0f to have rectangular windows. Large values tend to lead to variety of artifacts and are not recommended. + WindowBorderSize = 1.0f; // Thickness of border around windows. Generally set to 0.0f or 1.0f. Other values not well tested. + WindowMinSize = ImVec2(32,32); // Minimum window size + WindowTitleAlign = ImVec2(0.0f,0.5f);// Alignment for title bar text + WindowMenuButtonPosition= ImGuiDir_Left; // Position of the collapsing/docking button in the title bar (left/right). Defaults to ImGuiDir_Left. + ChildRounding = 0.0f; // Radius of child window corners rounding. Set to 0.0f to have rectangular child windows + ChildBorderSize = 1.0f; // Thickness of border around child windows. Generally set to 0.0f or 1.0f. Other values not well tested. + PopupRounding = 0.0f; // Radius of popup window corners rounding. Set to 0.0f to have rectangular child windows + PopupBorderSize = 1.0f; // Thickness of border around popup or tooltip windows. Generally set to 0.0f or 1.0f. Other values not well tested. + FramePadding = ImVec2(4,3); // Padding within a framed rectangle (used by most widgets) + FrameRounding = 0.0f; // Radius of frame corners rounding. Set to 0.0f to have rectangular frames (used by most widgets). + FrameBorderSize = 0.0f; // Thickness of border around frames. Generally set to 0.0f or 1.0f. Other values not well tested. + ItemSpacing = ImVec2(8,4); // Horizontal and vertical spacing between widgets/lines + ItemInnerSpacing = ImVec2(4,4); // Horizontal and vertical spacing between within elements of a composed widget (e.g. a slider and its label) + CellPadding = ImVec2(4,2); // Padding within a table cell + TouchExtraPadding = ImVec2(0,0); // Expand reactive bounding box for touch-based system where touch position is not accurate enough. Unfortunately we don't sort widgets so priority on overlap will always be given to the first widget. So don't grow this too much! + IndentSpacing = 21.0f; // Horizontal spacing when e.g. entering a tree node. Generally == (FontSize + FramePadding.x*2). + ColumnsMinSpacing = 6.0f; // Minimum horizontal spacing between two columns. Preferably > (FramePadding.x + 1). + ScrollbarSize = 14.0f; // Width of the vertical scrollbar, Height of the horizontal scrollbar + ScrollbarRounding = 9.0f; // Radius of grab corners rounding for scrollbar + GrabMinSize = 10.0f; // Minimum width/height of a grab box for slider/scrollbar + GrabRounding = 0.0f; // Radius of grabs corners rounding. Set to 0.0f to have rectangular slider grabs. + LogSliderDeadzone = 4.0f; // The size in pixels of the dead-zone around zero on logarithmic sliders that cross zero. + TabRounding = 4.0f; // Radius of upper corners of a tab. Set to 0.0f to have rectangular tabs. + TabBorderSize = 0.0f; // Thickness of border around tabs. + TabMinWidthForCloseButton = 0.0f; // Minimum width for close button to appears on an unselected tab when hovered. Set to 0.0f to always show when hovering, set to FLT_MAX to never show close button unless selected. + ColorButtonPosition = ImGuiDir_Right; // Side of the color button in the ColorEdit4 widget (left/right). Defaults to ImGuiDir_Right. + ButtonTextAlign = ImVec2(0.5f,0.5f);// Alignment of button text when button is larger than text. + SelectableTextAlign = ImVec2(0.0f,0.0f);// Alignment of selectable text. Defaults to (0.0f, 0.0f) (top-left aligned). It's generally important to keep this left-aligned if you want to lay multiple items on a same line. + DisplayWindowPadding = ImVec2(19,19); // Window position are clamped to be visible within the display area or monitors by at least this amount. Only applies to regular windows. + DisplaySafeAreaPadding = ImVec2(3,3); // If you cannot see the edge of your screen (e.g. on a TV) increase the safe area padding. Covers popups/tooltips as well regular windows. + MouseCursorScale = 1.0f; // Scale software rendered mouse cursor (when io.MouseDrawCursor is enabled). May be removed later. + AntiAliasedLines = true; // Enable anti-aliased lines/borders. Disable if you are really tight on CPU/GPU. + AntiAliasedLinesUseTex = true; // Enable anti-aliased lines/borders using textures where possible. Require backend to render with bilinear filtering. + AntiAliasedFill = true; // Enable anti-aliased filled shapes (rounded rectangles, circles, etc.). + CurveTessellationTol = 1.25f; // Tessellation tolerance when using PathBezierCurveTo() without a specific number of segments. Decrease for highly tessellated curves (higher quality, more polygons), increase to reduce quality. + CircleTessellationMaxError = 0.30f; // Maximum error (in pixels) allowed when using AddCircle()/AddCircleFilled() or drawing rounded corner rectangles with no explicit segment count specified. Decrease for higher quality but more geometry. + + // Default theme + ImGui::StyleColorsDark(this); +} + +// To scale your entire UI (e.g. if you want your app to use High DPI or generally be DPI aware) you may use this helper function. Scaling the fonts is done separately and is up to you. +// Important: This operation is lossy because we round all sizes to integer. If you need to change your scale multiples, call this over a freshly initialized ImGuiStyle structure rather than scaling multiple times. +void ImGuiStyle::ScaleAllSizes(float scale_factor) +{ + WindowPadding = ImFloor(WindowPadding * scale_factor); + WindowRounding = ImFloor(WindowRounding * scale_factor); + WindowMinSize = ImFloor(WindowMinSize * scale_factor); + ChildRounding = ImFloor(ChildRounding * scale_factor); + PopupRounding = ImFloor(PopupRounding * scale_factor); + FramePadding = ImFloor(FramePadding * scale_factor); + FrameRounding = ImFloor(FrameRounding * scale_factor); + ItemSpacing = ImFloor(ItemSpacing * scale_factor); + ItemInnerSpacing = ImFloor(ItemInnerSpacing * scale_factor); + CellPadding = ImFloor(CellPadding * scale_factor); + TouchExtraPadding = ImFloor(TouchExtraPadding * scale_factor); + IndentSpacing = ImFloor(IndentSpacing * scale_factor); + ColumnsMinSpacing = ImFloor(ColumnsMinSpacing * scale_factor); + ScrollbarSize = ImFloor(ScrollbarSize * scale_factor); + ScrollbarRounding = ImFloor(ScrollbarRounding * scale_factor); + GrabMinSize = ImFloor(GrabMinSize * scale_factor); + GrabRounding = ImFloor(GrabRounding * scale_factor); + LogSliderDeadzone = ImFloor(LogSliderDeadzone * scale_factor); + TabRounding = ImFloor(TabRounding * scale_factor); + TabMinWidthForCloseButton = (TabMinWidthForCloseButton != FLT_MAX) ? ImFloor(TabMinWidthForCloseButton * scale_factor) : FLT_MAX; + DisplayWindowPadding = ImFloor(DisplayWindowPadding * scale_factor); + DisplaySafeAreaPadding = ImFloor(DisplaySafeAreaPadding * scale_factor); + MouseCursorScale = ImFloor(MouseCursorScale * scale_factor); +} + +ImGuiIO::ImGuiIO() +{ + // Most fields are initialized with zero + memset(this, 0, sizeof(*this)); + IM_ASSERT(IM_ARRAYSIZE(ImGuiIO::MouseDown) == ImGuiMouseButton_COUNT && IM_ARRAYSIZE(ImGuiIO::MouseClicked) == ImGuiMouseButton_COUNT); // Our pre-C++11 IM_STATIC_ASSERT() macros triggers warning on modern compilers so we don't use it here. + + // Settings + ConfigFlags = ImGuiConfigFlags_None; + BackendFlags = ImGuiBackendFlags_None; + DisplaySize = ImVec2(-1.0f, -1.0f); + DeltaTime = 1.0f / 60.0f; + IniSavingRate = 5.0f; + IniFilename = "imgui.ini"; // Important: "imgui.ini" is relative to current working dir, most apps will want to lock this to an absolute path (e.g. same path as executables). + LogFilename = "imgui_log.txt"; + MouseDoubleClickTime = 0.30f; + MouseDoubleClickMaxDist = 6.0f; + for (int i = 0; i < ImGuiKey_COUNT; i++) + KeyMap[i] = -1; + KeyRepeatDelay = 0.275f; + KeyRepeatRate = 0.050f; + UserData = NULL; + + Fonts = NULL; + FontGlobalScale = 1.0f; + FontDefault = NULL; + FontAllowUserScaling = false; + DisplayFramebufferScale = ImVec2(1.0f, 1.0f); + + // Miscellaneous options + MouseDrawCursor = false; +#ifdef __APPLE__ + ConfigMacOSXBehaviors = true; // Set Mac OS X style defaults based on __APPLE__ compile time flag +#else + ConfigMacOSXBehaviors = false; +#endif + ConfigInputTextCursorBlink = true; + ConfigWindowsResizeFromEdges = true; + ConfigWindowsMoveFromTitleBarOnly = false; + ConfigMemoryCompactTimer = 60.0f; + + // Platform Functions + BackendPlatformName = BackendRendererName = NULL; + BackendPlatformUserData = BackendRendererUserData = BackendLanguageUserData = NULL; + GetClipboardTextFn = GetClipboardTextFn_DefaultImpl; // Platform dependent default implementations + SetClipboardTextFn = SetClipboardTextFn_DefaultImpl; + ClipboardUserData = NULL; + ImeSetInputScreenPosFn = ImeSetInputScreenPosFn_DefaultImpl; + ImeWindowHandle = NULL; + + // Input (NB: we already have memset zero the entire structure!) + MousePos = ImVec2(-FLT_MAX, -FLT_MAX); + MousePosPrev = ImVec2(-FLT_MAX, -FLT_MAX); + MouseDragThreshold = 6.0f; + for (int i = 0; i < IM_ARRAYSIZE(MouseDownDuration); i++) MouseDownDuration[i] = MouseDownDurationPrev[i] = -1.0f; + for (int i = 0; i < IM_ARRAYSIZE(KeysDownDuration); i++) KeysDownDuration[i] = KeysDownDurationPrev[i] = -1.0f; + for (int i = 0; i < IM_ARRAYSIZE(NavInputsDownDuration); i++) NavInputsDownDuration[i] = -1.0f; +} + +// Pass in translated ASCII characters for text input. +// - with glfw you can get those from the callback set in glfwSetCharCallback() +// - on Windows you can get those using ToAscii+keyboard state, or via the WM_CHAR message +void ImGuiIO::AddInputCharacter(unsigned int c) +{ + if (c != 0) + InputQueueCharacters.push_back(c <= IM_UNICODE_CODEPOINT_MAX ? (ImWchar)c : IM_UNICODE_CODEPOINT_INVALID); +} + +// UTF16 strings use surrogate pairs to encode codepoints >= 0x10000, so +// we should save the high surrogate. +void ImGuiIO::AddInputCharacterUTF16(ImWchar16 c) +{ + if (c == 0 && InputQueueSurrogate == 0) + return; + + if ((c & 0xFC00) == 0xD800) // High surrogate, must save + { + if (InputQueueSurrogate != 0) + InputQueueCharacters.push_back(IM_UNICODE_CODEPOINT_INVALID); + InputQueueSurrogate = c; + return; + } + + ImWchar cp = c; + if (InputQueueSurrogate != 0) + { + if ((c & 0xFC00) != 0xDC00) // Invalid low surrogate + { + InputQueueCharacters.push_back(IM_UNICODE_CODEPOINT_INVALID); + } + else + { +#if IM_UNICODE_CODEPOINT_MAX == 0xFFFF + cp = IM_UNICODE_CODEPOINT_INVALID; // Codepoint will not fit in ImWchar +#else + cp = (ImWchar)(((InputQueueSurrogate - 0xD800) << 10) + (c - 0xDC00) + 0x10000); +#endif + } + + InputQueueSurrogate = 0; + } + InputQueueCharacters.push_back(cp); +} + +void ImGuiIO::AddInputCharactersUTF8(const char* utf8_chars) +{ + while (*utf8_chars != 0) + { + unsigned int c = 0; + utf8_chars += ImTextCharFromUtf8(&c, utf8_chars, NULL); + if (c != 0) + InputQueueCharacters.push_back((ImWchar)c); + } +} + +void ImGuiIO::ClearInputCharacters() +{ + InputQueueCharacters.resize(0); +} + +void ImGuiIO::AddFocusEvent(bool focused) +{ + if (focused) + return; + + // Clear buttons state when focus is lost + // (this is useful so e.g. releasing Alt after focus loss on Alt-Tab doesn't trigger the Alt menu toggle) + memset(KeysDown, 0, sizeof(KeysDown)); + for (int n = 0; n < IM_ARRAYSIZE(KeysDownDuration); n++) + KeysDownDuration[n] = KeysDownDurationPrev[n] = -1.0f; + KeyCtrl = KeyShift = KeyAlt = KeySuper = false; + KeyMods = KeyModsPrev = ImGuiKeyModFlags_None; + for (int n = 0; n < IM_ARRAYSIZE(NavInputsDownDuration); n++) + NavInputsDownDuration[n] = NavInputsDownDurationPrev[n] = -1.0f; +} + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] MISC HELPERS/UTILITIES (Geometry functions) +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +ImVec2 ImBezierCubicClosestPoint(const ImVec2& p1, const ImVec2& p2, const ImVec2& p3, const ImVec2& p4, const ImVec2& p, int num_segments) +{ + IM_ASSERT(num_segments > 0); // Use ImBezierCubicClosestPointCasteljau() + ImVec2 p_last = p1; + ImVec2 p_closest; + float p_closest_dist2 = FLT_MAX; + float t_step = 1.0f / (float)num_segments; + for (int i_step = 1; i_step <= num_segments; i_step++) + { + ImVec2 p_current = ImBezierCubicCalc(p1, p2, p3, p4, t_step * i_step); + ImVec2 p_line = ImLineClosestPoint(p_last, p_current, p); + float dist2 = ImLengthSqr(p - p_line); + if (dist2 < p_closest_dist2) + { + p_closest = p_line; + p_closest_dist2 = dist2; + } + p_last = p_current; + } + return p_closest; +} + +// Closely mimics PathBezierToCasteljau() in imgui_draw.cpp +static void ImBezierCubicClosestPointCasteljauStep(const ImVec2& p, ImVec2& p_closest, ImVec2& p_last, float& p_closest_dist2, float x1, float y1, float x2, float y2, float x3, float y3, float x4, float y4, float tess_tol, int level) +{ + float dx = x4 - x1; + float dy = y4 - y1; + float d2 = ((x2 - x4) * dy - (y2 - y4) * dx); + float d3 = ((x3 - x4) * dy - (y3 - y4) * dx); + d2 = (d2 >= 0) ? d2 : -d2; + d3 = (d3 >= 0) ? d3 : -d3; + if ((d2 + d3) * (d2 + d3) < tess_tol * (dx * dx + dy * dy)) + { + ImVec2 p_current(x4, y4); + ImVec2 p_line = ImLineClosestPoint(p_last, p_current, p); + float dist2 = ImLengthSqr(p - p_line); + if (dist2 < p_closest_dist2) + { + p_closest = p_line; + p_closest_dist2 = dist2; + } + p_last = p_current; + } + else if (level < 10) + { + float x12 = (x1 + x2)*0.5f, y12 = (y1 + y2)*0.5f; + float x23 = (x2 + x3)*0.5f, y23 = (y2 + y3)*0.5f; + float x34 = (x3 + x4)*0.5f, y34 = (y3 + y4)*0.5f; + float x123 = (x12 + x23)*0.5f, y123 = (y12 + y23)*0.5f; + float x234 = (x23 + x34)*0.5f, y234 = (y23 + y34)*0.5f; + float x1234 = (x123 + x234)*0.5f, y1234 = (y123 + y234)*0.5f; + ImBezierCubicClosestPointCasteljauStep(p, p_closest, p_last, p_closest_dist2, x1, y1, x12, y12, x123, y123, x1234, y1234, tess_tol, level + 1); + ImBezierCubicClosestPointCasteljauStep(p, p_closest, p_last, p_closest_dist2, x1234, y1234, x234, y234, x34, y34, x4, y4, tess_tol, level + 1); + } +} + +// tess_tol is generally the same value you would find in ImGui::GetStyle().CurveTessellationTol +// Because those ImXXX functions are lower-level than ImGui:: we cannot access this value automatically. +ImVec2 ImBezierCubicClosestPointCasteljau(const ImVec2& p1, const ImVec2& p2, const ImVec2& p3, const ImVec2& p4, const ImVec2& p, float tess_tol) +{ + IM_ASSERT(tess_tol > 0.0f); + ImVec2 p_last = p1; + ImVec2 p_closest; + float p_closest_dist2 = FLT_MAX; + ImBezierCubicClosestPointCasteljauStep(p, p_closest, p_last, p_closest_dist2, p1.x, p1.y, p2.x, p2.y, p3.x, p3.y, p4.x, p4.y, tess_tol, 0); + return p_closest; +} + +ImVec2 ImLineClosestPoint(const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& b, const ImVec2& p) +{ + ImVec2 ap = p - a; + ImVec2 ab_dir = b - a; + float dot = ap.x * ab_dir.x + ap.y * ab_dir.y; + if (dot < 0.0f) + return a; + float ab_len_sqr = ab_dir.x * ab_dir.x + ab_dir.y * ab_dir.y; + if (dot > ab_len_sqr) + return b; + return a + ab_dir * dot / ab_len_sqr; +} + +bool ImTriangleContainsPoint(const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& b, const ImVec2& c, const ImVec2& p) +{ + bool b1 = ((p.x - b.x) * (a.y - b.y) - (p.y - b.y) * (a.x - b.x)) < 0.0f; + bool b2 = ((p.x - c.x) * (b.y - c.y) - (p.y - c.y) * (b.x - c.x)) < 0.0f; + bool b3 = ((p.x - a.x) * (c.y - a.y) - (p.y - a.y) * (c.x - a.x)) < 0.0f; + return ((b1 == b2) && (b2 == b3)); +} + +void ImTriangleBarycentricCoords(const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& b, const ImVec2& c, const ImVec2& p, float& out_u, float& out_v, float& out_w) +{ + ImVec2 v0 = b - a; + ImVec2 v1 = c - a; + ImVec2 v2 = p - a; + const float denom = v0.x * v1.y - v1.x * v0.y; + out_v = (v2.x * v1.y - v1.x * v2.y) / denom; + out_w = (v0.x * v2.y - v2.x * v0.y) / denom; + out_u = 1.0f - out_v - out_w; +} + +ImVec2 ImTriangleClosestPoint(const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& b, const ImVec2& c, const ImVec2& p) +{ + ImVec2 proj_ab = ImLineClosestPoint(a, b, p); + ImVec2 proj_bc = ImLineClosestPoint(b, c, p); + ImVec2 proj_ca = ImLineClosestPoint(c, a, p); + float dist2_ab = ImLengthSqr(p - proj_ab); + float dist2_bc = ImLengthSqr(p - proj_bc); + float dist2_ca = ImLengthSqr(p - proj_ca); + float m = ImMin(dist2_ab, ImMin(dist2_bc, dist2_ca)); + if (m == dist2_ab) + return proj_ab; + if (m == dist2_bc) + return proj_bc; + return proj_ca; +} + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] MISC HELPERS/UTILITIES (String, Format, Hash functions) +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// Consider using _stricmp/_strnicmp under Windows or strcasecmp/strncasecmp. We don't actually use either ImStricmp/ImStrnicmp in the codebase any more. +int ImStricmp(const char* str1, const char* str2) +{ + int d; + while ((d = toupper(*str2) - toupper(*str1)) == 0 && *str1) { str1++; str2++; } + return d; +} + +int ImStrnicmp(const char* str1, const char* str2, size_t count) +{ + int d = 0; + while (count > 0 && (d = toupper(*str2) - toupper(*str1)) == 0 && *str1) { str1++; str2++; count--; } + return d; +} + +void ImStrncpy(char* dst, const char* src, size_t count) +{ + if (count < 1) + return; + if (count > 1) + strncpy(dst, src, count - 1); + dst[count - 1] = 0; +} + +char* ImStrdup(const char* str) +{ + size_t len = strlen(str); + void* buf = IM_ALLOC(len + 1); + return (char*)memcpy(buf, (const void*)str, len + 1); +} + +char* ImStrdupcpy(char* dst, size_t* p_dst_size, const char* src) +{ + size_t dst_buf_size = p_dst_size ? *p_dst_size : strlen(dst) + 1; + size_t src_size = strlen(src) + 1; + if (dst_buf_size < src_size) + { + IM_FREE(dst); + dst = (char*)IM_ALLOC(src_size); + if (p_dst_size) + *p_dst_size = src_size; + } + return (char*)memcpy(dst, (const void*)src, src_size); +} + +const char* ImStrchrRange(const char* str, const char* str_end, char c) +{ + const char* p = (const char*)memchr(str, (int)c, str_end - str); + return p; +} + +int ImStrlenW(const ImWchar* str) +{ + //return (int)wcslen((const wchar_t*)str); // FIXME-OPT: Could use this when wchar_t are 16-bit + int n = 0; + while (*str++) n++; + return n; +} + +// Find end-of-line. Return pointer will point to either first \n, either str_end. +const char* ImStreolRange(const char* str, const char* str_end) +{ + const char* p = (const char*)memchr(str, '\n', str_end - str); + return p ? p : str_end; +} + +const ImWchar* ImStrbolW(const ImWchar* buf_mid_line, const ImWchar* buf_begin) // find beginning-of-line +{ + while (buf_mid_line > buf_begin && buf_mid_line[-1] != '\n') + buf_mid_line--; + return buf_mid_line; +} + +const char* ImStristr(const char* haystack, const char* haystack_end, const char* needle, const char* needle_end) +{ + if (!needle_end) + needle_end = needle + strlen(needle); + + const char un0 = (char)toupper(*needle); + while ((!haystack_end && *haystack) || (haystack_end && haystack < haystack_end)) + { + if (toupper(*haystack) == un0) + { + const char* b = needle + 1; + for (const char* a = haystack + 1; b < needle_end; a++, b++) + if (toupper(*a) != toupper(*b)) + break; + if (b == needle_end) + return haystack; + } + haystack++; + } + return NULL; +} + +// Trim str by offsetting contents when there's leading data + writing a \0 at the trailing position. We use this in situation where the cost is negligible. +void ImStrTrimBlanks(char* buf) +{ + char* p = buf; + while (p[0] == ' ' || p[0] == '\t') // Leading blanks + p++; + char* p_start = p; + while (*p != 0) // Find end of string + p++; + while (p > p_start && (p[-1] == ' ' || p[-1] == '\t')) // Trailing blanks + p--; + if (p_start != buf) // Copy memory if we had leading blanks + memmove(buf, p_start, p - p_start); + buf[p - p_start] = 0; // Zero terminate +} + +const char* ImStrSkipBlank(const char* str) +{ + while (str[0] == ' ' || str[0] == '\t') + str++; + return str; +} + +// A) MSVC version appears to return -1 on overflow, whereas glibc appears to return total count (which may be >= buf_size). +// Ideally we would test for only one of those limits at runtime depending on the behavior the vsnprintf(), but trying to deduct it at compile time sounds like a pandora can of worm. +// B) When buf==NULL vsnprintf() will return the output size. +#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_DEFAULT_FORMAT_FUNCTIONS + +// We support stb_sprintf which is much faster (see: https://github.com/nothings/stb/blob/master/stb_sprintf.h) +// You may set IMGUI_USE_STB_SPRINTF to use our default wrapper, or set IMGUI_DISABLE_DEFAULT_FORMAT_FUNCTIONS +// and setup the wrapper yourself. (FIXME-OPT: Some of our high-level operations such as ImGuiTextBuffer::appendfv() are +// designed using two-passes worst case, which probably could be improved using the stbsp_vsprintfcb() function.) +#ifdef IMGUI_USE_STB_SPRINTF +#define STB_SPRINTF_IMPLEMENTATION +#include "stb_sprintf.h" +#endif + +#if defined(_MSC_VER) && !defined(vsnprintf) +#define vsnprintf _vsnprintf +#endif + +int ImFormatString(char* buf, size_t buf_size, const char* fmt, ...) +{ + va_list args; + va_start(args, fmt); +#ifdef IMGUI_USE_STB_SPRINTF + int w = stbsp_vsnprintf(buf, (int)buf_size, fmt, args); +#else + int w = vsnprintf(buf, buf_size, fmt, args); +#endif + va_end(args); + if (buf == NULL) + return w; + if (w == -1 || w >= (int)buf_size) + w = (int)buf_size - 1; + buf[w] = 0; + return w; +} + +int ImFormatStringV(char* buf, size_t buf_size, const char* fmt, va_list args) +{ +#ifdef IMGUI_USE_STB_SPRINTF + int w = stbsp_vsnprintf(buf, (int)buf_size, fmt, args); +#else + int w = vsnprintf(buf, buf_size, fmt, args); +#endif + if (buf == NULL) + return w; + if (w == -1 || w >= (int)buf_size) + w = (int)buf_size - 1; + buf[w] = 0; + return w; +} +#endif // #ifdef IMGUI_DISABLE_DEFAULT_FORMAT_FUNCTIONS + +// CRC32 needs a 1KB lookup table (not cache friendly) +// Although the code to generate the table is simple and shorter than the table itself, using a const table allows us to easily: +// - avoid an unnecessary branch/memory tap, - keep the ImHashXXX functions usable by static constructors, - make it thread-safe. +static const ImU32 GCrc32LookupTable[256] = +{ + 0x00000000,0x77073096,0xEE0E612C,0x990951BA,0x076DC419,0x706AF48F,0xE963A535,0x9E6495A3,0x0EDB8832,0x79DCB8A4,0xE0D5E91E,0x97D2D988,0x09B64C2B,0x7EB17CBD,0xE7B82D07,0x90BF1D91, + 0x1DB71064,0x6AB020F2,0xF3B97148,0x84BE41DE,0x1ADAD47D,0x6DDDE4EB,0xF4D4B551,0x83D385C7,0x136C9856,0x646BA8C0,0xFD62F97A,0x8A65C9EC,0x14015C4F,0x63066CD9,0xFA0F3D63,0x8D080DF5, + 0x3B6E20C8,0x4C69105E,0xD56041E4,0xA2677172,0x3C03E4D1,0x4B04D447,0xD20D85FD,0xA50AB56B,0x35B5A8FA,0x42B2986C,0xDBBBC9D6,0xACBCF940,0x32D86CE3,0x45DF5C75,0xDCD60DCF,0xABD13D59, + 0x26D930AC,0x51DE003A,0xC8D75180,0xBFD06116,0x21B4F4B5,0x56B3C423,0xCFBA9599,0xB8BDA50F,0x2802B89E,0x5F058808,0xC60CD9B2,0xB10BE924,0x2F6F7C87,0x58684C11,0xC1611DAB,0xB6662D3D, + 0x76DC4190,0x01DB7106,0x98D220BC,0xEFD5102A,0x71B18589,0x06B6B51F,0x9FBFE4A5,0xE8B8D433,0x7807C9A2,0x0F00F934,0x9609A88E,0xE10E9818,0x7F6A0DBB,0x086D3D2D,0x91646C97,0xE6635C01, + 0x6B6B51F4,0x1C6C6162,0x856530D8,0xF262004E,0x6C0695ED,0x1B01A57B,0x8208F4C1,0xF50FC457,0x65B0D9C6,0x12B7E950,0x8BBEB8EA,0xFCB9887C,0x62DD1DDF,0x15DA2D49,0x8CD37CF3,0xFBD44C65, + 0x4DB26158,0x3AB551CE,0xA3BC0074,0xD4BB30E2,0x4ADFA541,0x3DD895D7,0xA4D1C46D,0xD3D6F4FB,0x4369E96A,0x346ED9FC,0xAD678846,0xDA60B8D0,0x44042D73,0x33031DE5,0xAA0A4C5F,0xDD0D7CC9, + 0x5005713C,0x270241AA,0xBE0B1010,0xC90C2086,0x5768B525,0x206F85B3,0xB966D409,0xCE61E49F,0x5EDEF90E,0x29D9C998,0xB0D09822,0xC7D7A8B4,0x59B33D17,0x2EB40D81,0xB7BD5C3B,0xC0BA6CAD, + 0xEDB88320,0x9ABFB3B6,0x03B6E20C,0x74B1D29A,0xEAD54739,0x9DD277AF,0x04DB2615,0x73DC1683,0xE3630B12,0x94643B84,0x0D6D6A3E,0x7A6A5AA8,0xE40ECF0B,0x9309FF9D,0x0A00AE27,0x7D079EB1, + 0xF00F9344,0x8708A3D2,0x1E01F268,0x6906C2FE,0xF762575D,0x806567CB,0x196C3671,0x6E6B06E7,0xFED41B76,0x89D32BE0,0x10DA7A5A,0x67DD4ACC,0xF9B9DF6F,0x8EBEEFF9,0x17B7BE43,0x60B08ED5, + 0xD6D6A3E8,0xA1D1937E,0x38D8C2C4,0x4FDFF252,0xD1BB67F1,0xA6BC5767,0x3FB506DD,0x48B2364B,0xD80D2BDA,0xAF0A1B4C,0x36034AF6,0x41047A60,0xDF60EFC3,0xA867DF55,0x316E8EEF,0x4669BE79, + 0xCB61B38C,0xBC66831A,0x256FD2A0,0x5268E236,0xCC0C7795,0xBB0B4703,0x220216B9,0x5505262F,0xC5BA3BBE,0xB2BD0B28,0x2BB45A92,0x5CB36A04,0xC2D7FFA7,0xB5D0CF31,0x2CD99E8B,0x5BDEAE1D, + 0x9B64C2B0,0xEC63F226,0x756AA39C,0x026D930A,0x9C0906A9,0xEB0E363F,0x72076785,0x05005713,0x95BF4A82,0xE2B87A14,0x7BB12BAE,0x0CB61B38,0x92D28E9B,0xE5D5BE0D,0x7CDCEFB7,0x0BDBDF21, + 0x86D3D2D4,0xF1D4E242,0x68DDB3F8,0x1FDA836E,0x81BE16CD,0xF6B9265B,0x6FB077E1,0x18B74777,0x88085AE6,0xFF0F6A70,0x66063BCA,0x11010B5C,0x8F659EFF,0xF862AE69,0x616BFFD3,0x166CCF45, + 0xA00AE278,0xD70DD2EE,0x4E048354,0x3903B3C2,0xA7672661,0xD06016F7,0x4969474D,0x3E6E77DB,0xAED16A4A,0xD9D65ADC,0x40DF0B66,0x37D83BF0,0xA9BCAE53,0xDEBB9EC5,0x47B2CF7F,0x30B5FFE9, + 0xBDBDF21C,0xCABAC28A,0x53B39330,0x24B4A3A6,0xBAD03605,0xCDD70693,0x54DE5729,0x23D967BF,0xB3667A2E,0xC4614AB8,0x5D681B02,0x2A6F2B94,0xB40BBE37,0xC30C8EA1,0x5A05DF1B,0x2D02EF8D, +}; + +// Known size hash +// It is ok to call ImHashData on a string with known length but the ### operator won't be supported. +// FIXME-OPT: Replace with e.g. FNV1a hash? CRC32 pretty much randomly access 1KB. Need to do proper measurements. +ImGuiID ImHashData(const void* data_p, size_t data_size, ImU32 seed) +{ + ImU32 crc = ~seed; + const unsigned char* data = (const unsigned char*)data_p; + const ImU32* crc32_lut = GCrc32LookupTable; + while (data_size-- != 0) + crc = (crc >> 8) ^ crc32_lut[(crc & 0xFF) ^ *data++]; + return ~crc; +} + +// Zero-terminated string hash, with support for ### to reset back to seed value +// We support a syntax of "label###id" where only "###id" is included in the hash, and only "label" gets displayed. +// Because this syntax is rarely used we are optimizing for the common case. +// - If we reach ### in the string we discard the hash so far and reset to the seed. +// - We don't do 'current += 2; continue;' after handling ### to keep the code smaller/faster (measured ~10% diff in Debug build) +// FIXME-OPT: Replace with e.g. FNV1a hash? CRC32 pretty much randomly access 1KB. Need to do proper measurements. +ImGuiID ImHashStr(const char* data_p, size_t data_size, ImU32 seed) +{ + seed = ~seed; + ImU32 crc = seed; + const unsigned char* data = (const unsigned char*)data_p; + const ImU32* crc32_lut = GCrc32LookupTable; + if (data_size != 0) + { + while (data_size-- != 0) + { + unsigned char c = *data++; + if (c == '#' && data_size >= 2 && data[0] == '#' && data[1] == '#') + crc = seed; + crc = (crc >> 8) ^ crc32_lut[(crc & 0xFF) ^ c]; + } + } + else + { + while (unsigned char c = *data++) + { + if (c == '#' && data[0] == '#' && data[1] == '#') + crc = seed; + crc = (crc >> 8) ^ crc32_lut[(crc & 0xFF) ^ c]; + } + } + return ~crc; +} + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] MISC HELPERS/UTILITIES (File functions) +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// Default file functions +#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_DEFAULT_FILE_FUNCTIONS + +ImFileHandle ImFileOpen(const char* filename, const char* mode) +{ +#if defined(_WIN32) && !defined(IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_FUNCTIONS) && !defined(__CYGWIN__) && !defined(__GNUC__) + // We need a fopen() wrapper because MSVC/Windows fopen doesn't handle UTF-8 filenames. + // Previously we used ImTextCountCharsFromUtf8/ImTextStrFromUtf8 here but we now need to support ImWchar16 and ImWchar32! + const int filename_wsize = ::MultiByteToWideChar(CP_UTF8, 0, filename, -1, NULL, 0); + const int mode_wsize = ::MultiByteToWideChar(CP_UTF8, 0, mode, -1, NULL, 0); + ImVector buf; + buf.resize(filename_wsize + mode_wsize); + ::MultiByteToWideChar(CP_UTF8, 0, filename, -1, (wchar_t*)&buf[0], filename_wsize); + ::MultiByteToWideChar(CP_UTF8, 0, mode, -1, (wchar_t*)&buf[filename_wsize], mode_wsize); + return ::_wfopen((const wchar_t*)&buf[0], (const wchar_t*)&buf[filename_wsize]); +#else + return fopen(filename, mode); +#endif +} + +// We should in theory be using fseeko()/ftello() with off_t and _fseeki64()/_ftelli64() with __int64, waiting for the PR that does that in a very portable pre-C++11 zero-warnings way. +bool ImFileClose(ImFileHandle f) { return fclose(f) == 0; } +ImU64 ImFileGetSize(ImFileHandle f) { long off = 0, sz = 0; return ((off = ftell(f)) != -1 && !fseek(f, 0, SEEK_END) && (sz = ftell(f)) != -1 && !fseek(f, off, SEEK_SET)) ? (ImU64)sz : (ImU64)-1; } +ImU64 ImFileRead(void* data, ImU64 sz, ImU64 count, ImFileHandle f) { return fread(data, (size_t)sz, (size_t)count, f); } +ImU64 ImFileWrite(const void* data, ImU64 sz, ImU64 count, ImFileHandle f) { return fwrite(data, (size_t)sz, (size_t)count, f); } +#endif // #ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_DEFAULT_FILE_FUNCTIONS + +// Helper: Load file content into memory +// Memory allocated with IM_ALLOC(), must be freed by user using IM_FREE() == ImGui::MemFree() +// This can't really be used with "rt" because fseek size won't match read size. +void* ImFileLoadToMemory(const char* filename, const char* mode, size_t* out_file_size, int padding_bytes) +{ + IM_ASSERT(filename && mode); + if (out_file_size) + *out_file_size = 0; + + ImFileHandle f; + if ((f = ImFileOpen(filename, mode)) == NULL) + return NULL; + + size_t file_size = (size_t)ImFileGetSize(f); + if (file_size == (size_t)-1) + { + ImFileClose(f); + return NULL; + } + + void* file_data = IM_ALLOC(file_size + padding_bytes); + if (file_data == NULL) + { + ImFileClose(f); + return NULL; + } + if (ImFileRead(file_data, 1, file_size, f) != file_size) + { + ImFileClose(f); + IM_FREE(file_data); + return NULL; + } + if (padding_bytes > 0) + memset((void*)(((char*)file_data) + file_size), 0, (size_t)padding_bytes); + + ImFileClose(f); + if (out_file_size) + *out_file_size = file_size; + + return file_data; +} + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] MISC HELPERS/UTILITIES (ImText* functions) +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// Convert UTF-8 to 32-bit character, process single character input. +// A nearly-branchless UTF-8 decoder, based on work of Christopher Wellons (https://github.com/skeeto/branchless-utf8). +// We handle UTF-8 decoding error by skipping forward. +int ImTextCharFromUtf8(unsigned int* out_char, const char* in_text, const char* in_text_end) +{ + static const char lengths[32] = { 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 2, 2, 2, 2, 3, 3, 4, 0 }; + static const int masks[] = { 0x00, 0x7f, 0x1f, 0x0f, 0x07 }; + static const uint32_t mins[] = { 0x400000, 0, 0x80, 0x800, 0x10000 }; + static const int shiftc[] = { 0, 18, 12, 6, 0 }; + static const int shifte[] = { 0, 6, 4, 2, 0 }; + int len = lengths[*(const unsigned char*)in_text >> 3]; + int wanted = len + !len; + + if (in_text_end == NULL) + in_text_end = in_text + wanted; // Max length, nulls will be taken into account. + + // Copy at most 'len' bytes, stop copying at 0 or past in_text_end. Branch predictor does a good job here, + // so it is fast even with excessive branching. + unsigned char s[4]; + s[0] = in_text + 0 < in_text_end ? in_text[0] : 0; + s[1] = in_text + 1 < in_text_end ? in_text[1] : 0; + s[2] = in_text + 2 < in_text_end ? in_text[2] : 0; + s[3] = in_text + 3 < in_text_end ? in_text[3] : 0; + + // Assume a four-byte character and load four bytes. Unused bits are shifted out. + *out_char = (uint32_t)(s[0] & masks[len]) << 18; + *out_char |= (uint32_t)(s[1] & 0x3f) << 12; + *out_char |= (uint32_t)(s[2] & 0x3f) << 6; + *out_char |= (uint32_t)(s[3] & 0x3f) << 0; + *out_char >>= shiftc[len]; + + // Accumulate the various error conditions. + int e = 0; + e = (*out_char < mins[len]) << 6; // non-canonical encoding + e |= ((*out_char >> 11) == 0x1b) << 7; // surrogate half? + e |= (*out_char > IM_UNICODE_CODEPOINT_MAX) << 8; // out of range? + e |= (s[1] & 0xc0) >> 2; + e |= (s[2] & 0xc0) >> 4; + e |= (s[3] ) >> 6; + e ^= 0x2a; // top two bits of each tail byte correct? + e >>= shifte[len]; + + if (e) + { + // No bytes are consumed when *in_text == 0 || in_text == in_text_end. + // One byte is consumed in case of invalid first byte of in_text. + // All available bytes (at most `len` bytes) are consumed on incomplete/invalid second to last bytes. + // Invalid or incomplete input may consume less bytes than wanted, therefore every byte has to be inspected in s. + wanted = ImMin(wanted, !!s[0] + !!s[1] + !!s[2] + !!s[3]); + *out_char = IM_UNICODE_CODEPOINT_INVALID; + } + + return wanted; +} + +int ImTextStrFromUtf8(ImWchar* buf, int buf_size, const char* in_text, const char* in_text_end, const char** in_text_remaining) +{ + ImWchar* buf_out = buf; + ImWchar* buf_end = buf + buf_size; + while (buf_out < buf_end - 1 && (!in_text_end || in_text < in_text_end) && *in_text) + { + unsigned int c; + in_text += ImTextCharFromUtf8(&c, in_text, in_text_end); + if (c == 0) + break; + *buf_out++ = (ImWchar)c; + } + *buf_out = 0; + if (in_text_remaining) + *in_text_remaining = in_text; + return (int)(buf_out - buf); +} + +int ImTextCountCharsFromUtf8(const char* in_text, const char* in_text_end) +{ + int char_count = 0; + while ((!in_text_end || in_text < in_text_end) && *in_text) + { + unsigned int c; + in_text += ImTextCharFromUtf8(&c, in_text, in_text_end); + if (c == 0) + break; + char_count++; + } + return char_count; +} + +// Based on stb_to_utf8() from github.com/nothings/stb/ +static inline int ImTextCharToUtf8_inline(char* buf, int buf_size, unsigned int c) +{ + if (c < 0x80) + { + buf[0] = (char)c; + return 1; + } + if (c < 0x800) + { + if (buf_size < 2) return 0; + buf[0] = (char)(0xc0 + (c >> 6)); + buf[1] = (char)(0x80 + (c & 0x3f)); + return 2; + } + if (c < 0x10000) + { + if (buf_size < 3) return 0; + buf[0] = (char)(0xe0 + (c >> 12)); + buf[1] = (char)(0x80 + ((c >> 6) & 0x3f)); + buf[2] = (char)(0x80 + ((c ) & 0x3f)); + return 3; + } + if (c <= 0x10FFFF) + { + if (buf_size < 4) return 0; + buf[0] = (char)(0xf0 + (c >> 18)); + buf[1] = (char)(0x80 + ((c >> 12) & 0x3f)); + buf[2] = (char)(0x80 + ((c >> 6) & 0x3f)); + buf[3] = (char)(0x80 + ((c ) & 0x3f)); + return 4; + } + // Invalid code point, the max unicode is 0x10FFFF + return 0; +} + +const char* ImTextCharToUtf8(char out_buf[5], unsigned int c) +{ + int count = ImTextCharToUtf8_inline(out_buf, 5, c); + out_buf[count] = 0; + return out_buf; +} + +// Not optimal but we very rarely use this function. +int ImTextCountUtf8BytesFromChar(const char* in_text, const char* in_text_end) +{ + unsigned int unused = 0; + return ImTextCharFromUtf8(&unused, in_text, in_text_end); +} + +static inline int ImTextCountUtf8BytesFromChar(unsigned int c) +{ + if (c < 0x80) return 1; + if (c < 0x800) return 2; + if (c < 0x10000) return 3; + if (c <= 0x10FFFF) return 4; + return 3; +} + +int ImTextStrToUtf8(char* out_buf, int out_buf_size, const ImWchar* in_text, const ImWchar* in_text_end) +{ + char* buf_p = out_buf; + const char* buf_end = out_buf + out_buf_size; + while (buf_p < buf_end - 1 && (!in_text_end || in_text < in_text_end) && *in_text) + { + unsigned int c = (unsigned int)(*in_text++); + if (c < 0x80) + *buf_p++ = (char)c; + else + buf_p += ImTextCharToUtf8_inline(buf_p, (int)(buf_end - buf_p - 1), c); + } + *buf_p = 0; + return (int)(buf_p - out_buf); +} + +int ImTextCountUtf8BytesFromStr(const ImWchar* in_text, const ImWchar* in_text_end) +{ + int bytes_count = 0; + while ((!in_text_end || in_text < in_text_end) && *in_text) + { + unsigned int c = (unsigned int)(*in_text++); + if (c < 0x80) + bytes_count++; + else + bytes_count += ImTextCountUtf8BytesFromChar(c); + } + return bytes_count; +} + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] MISC HELPERS/UTILITIES (Color functions) +// Note: The Convert functions are early design which are not consistent with other API. +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +IMGUI_API ImU32 ImAlphaBlendColors(ImU32 col_a, ImU32 col_b) +{ + float t = ((col_b >> IM_COL32_A_SHIFT) & 0xFF) / 255.f; + int r = ImLerp((int)(col_a >> IM_COL32_R_SHIFT) & 0xFF, (int)(col_b >> IM_COL32_R_SHIFT) & 0xFF, t); + int g = ImLerp((int)(col_a >> IM_COL32_G_SHIFT) & 0xFF, (int)(col_b >> IM_COL32_G_SHIFT) & 0xFF, t); + int b = ImLerp((int)(col_a >> IM_COL32_B_SHIFT) & 0xFF, (int)(col_b >> IM_COL32_B_SHIFT) & 0xFF, t); + return IM_COL32(r, g, b, 0xFF); +} + +ImVec4 ImGui::ColorConvertU32ToFloat4(ImU32 in) +{ + float s = 1.0f / 255.0f; + return ImVec4( + ((in >> IM_COL32_R_SHIFT) & 0xFF) * s, + ((in >> IM_COL32_G_SHIFT) & 0xFF) * s, + ((in >> IM_COL32_B_SHIFT) & 0xFF) * s, + ((in >> IM_COL32_A_SHIFT) & 0xFF) * s); +} + +ImU32 ImGui::ColorConvertFloat4ToU32(const ImVec4& in) +{ + ImU32 out; + out = ((ImU32)IM_F32_TO_INT8_SAT(in.x)) << IM_COL32_R_SHIFT; + out |= ((ImU32)IM_F32_TO_INT8_SAT(in.y)) << IM_COL32_G_SHIFT; + out |= ((ImU32)IM_F32_TO_INT8_SAT(in.z)) << IM_COL32_B_SHIFT; + out |= ((ImU32)IM_F32_TO_INT8_SAT(in.w)) << IM_COL32_A_SHIFT; + return out; +} + +// Convert rgb floats ([0-1],[0-1],[0-1]) to hsv floats ([0-1],[0-1],[0-1]), from Foley & van Dam p592 +// Optimized http://lolengine.net/blog/2013/01/13/fast-rgb-to-hsv +void ImGui::ColorConvertRGBtoHSV(float r, float g, float b, float& out_h, float& out_s, float& out_v) +{ + float K = 0.f; + if (g < b) + { + ImSwap(g, b); + K = -1.f; + } + if (r < g) + { + ImSwap(r, g); + K = -2.f / 6.f - K; + } + + const float chroma = r - (g < b ? g : b); + out_h = ImFabs(K + (g - b) / (6.f * chroma + 1e-20f)); + out_s = chroma / (r + 1e-20f); + out_v = r; +} + +// Convert hsv floats ([0-1],[0-1],[0-1]) to rgb floats ([0-1],[0-1],[0-1]), from Foley & van Dam p593 +// also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/HSL_and_HSV +void ImGui::ColorConvertHSVtoRGB(float h, float s, float v, float& out_r, float& out_g, float& out_b) +{ + if (s == 0.0f) + { + // gray + out_r = out_g = out_b = v; + return; + } + + h = ImFmod(h, 1.0f) / (60.0f / 360.0f); + int i = (int)h; + float f = h - (float)i; + float p = v * (1.0f - s); + float q = v * (1.0f - s * f); + float t = v * (1.0f - s * (1.0f - f)); + + switch (i) + { + case 0: out_r = v; out_g = t; out_b = p; break; + case 1: out_r = q; out_g = v; out_b = p; break; + case 2: out_r = p; out_g = v; out_b = t; break; + case 3: out_r = p; out_g = q; out_b = v; break; + case 4: out_r = t; out_g = p; out_b = v; break; + case 5: default: out_r = v; out_g = p; out_b = q; break; + } +} + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] ImGuiStorage +// Helper: Key->value storage +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// std::lower_bound but without the bullshit +static ImGuiStorage::ImGuiStoragePair* LowerBound(ImVector& data, ImGuiID key) +{ + ImGuiStorage::ImGuiStoragePair* first = data.Data; + ImGuiStorage::ImGuiStoragePair* last = data.Data + data.Size; + size_t count = (size_t)(last - first); + while (count > 0) + { + size_t count2 = count >> 1; + ImGuiStorage::ImGuiStoragePair* mid = first + count2; + if (mid->key < key) + { + first = ++mid; + count -= count2 + 1; + } + else + { + count = count2; + } + } + return first; +} + +// For quicker full rebuild of a storage (instead of an incremental one), you may add all your contents and then sort once. +void ImGuiStorage::BuildSortByKey() +{ + struct StaticFunc + { + static int IMGUI_CDECL PairCompareByID(const void* lhs, const void* rhs) + { + // We can't just do a subtraction because qsort uses signed integers and subtracting our ID doesn't play well with that. + if (((const ImGuiStoragePair*)lhs)->key > ((const ImGuiStoragePair*)rhs)->key) return +1; + if (((const ImGuiStoragePair*)lhs)->key < ((const ImGuiStoragePair*)rhs)->key) return -1; + return 0; + } + }; + if (Data.Size > 1) + ImQsort(Data.Data, (size_t)Data.Size, sizeof(ImGuiStoragePair), StaticFunc::PairCompareByID); +} + +int ImGuiStorage::GetInt(ImGuiID key, int default_val) const +{ + ImGuiStoragePair* it = LowerBound(const_cast&>(Data), key); + if (it == Data.end() || it->key != key) + return default_val; + return it->val_i; +} + +bool ImGuiStorage::GetBool(ImGuiID key, bool default_val) const +{ + return GetInt(key, default_val ? 1 : 0) != 0; +} + +float ImGuiStorage::GetFloat(ImGuiID key, float default_val) const +{ + ImGuiStoragePair* it = LowerBound(const_cast&>(Data), key); + if (it == Data.end() || it->key != key) + return default_val; + return it->val_f; +} + +void* ImGuiStorage::GetVoidPtr(ImGuiID key) const +{ + ImGuiStoragePair* it = LowerBound(const_cast&>(Data), key); + if (it == Data.end() || it->key != key) + return NULL; + return it->val_p; +} + +// References are only valid until a new value is added to the storage. Calling a Set***() function or a Get***Ref() function invalidates the pointer. +int* ImGuiStorage::GetIntRef(ImGuiID key, int default_val) +{ + ImGuiStoragePair* it = LowerBound(Data, key); + if (it == Data.end() || it->key != key) + it = Data.insert(it, ImGuiStoragePair(key, default_val)); + return &it->val_i; +} + +bool* ImGuiStorage::GetBoolRef(ImGuiID key, bool default_val) +{ + return (bool*)GetIntRef(key, default_val ? 1 : 0); +} + +float* ImGuiStorage::GetFloatRef(ImGuiID key, float default_val) +{ + ImGuiStoragePair* it = LowerBound(Data, key); + if (it == Data.end() || it->key != key) + it = Data.insert(it, ImGuiStoragePair(key, default_val)); + return &it->val_f; +} + +void** ImGuiStorage::GetVoidPtrRef(ImGuiID key, void* default_val) +{ + ImGuiStoragePair* it = LowerBound(Data, key); + if (it == Data.end() || it->key != key) + it = Data.insert(it, ImGuiStoragePair(key, default_val)); + return &it->val_p; +} + +// FIXME-OPT: Need a way to reuse the result of lower_bound when doing GetInt()/SetInt() - not too bad because it only happens on explicit interaction (maximum one a frame) +void ImGuiStorage::SetInt(ImGuiID key, int val) +{ + ImGuiStoragePair* it = LowerBound(Data, key); + if (it == Data.end() || it->key != key) + { + Data.insert(it, ImGuiStoragePair(key, val)); + return; + } + it->val_i = val; +} + +void ImGuiStorage::SetBool(ImGuiID key, bool val) +{ + SetInt(key, val ? 1 : 0); +} + +void ImGuiStorage::SetFloat(ImGuiID key, float val) +{ + ImGuiStoragePair* it = LowerBound(Data, key); + if (it == Data.end() || it->key != key) + { + Data.insert(it, ImGuiStoragePair(key, val)); + return; + } + it->val_f = val; +} + +void ImGuiStorage::SetVoidPtr(ImGuiID key, void* val) +{ + ImGuiStoragePair* it = LowerBound(Data, key); + if (it == Data.end() || it->key != key) + { + Data.insert(it, ImGuiStoragePair(key, val)); + return; + } + it->val_p = val; +} + +void ImGuiStorage::SetAllInt(int v) +{ + for (int i = 0; i < Data.Size; i++) + Data[i].val_i = v; +} + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] ImGuiTextFilter +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// Helper: Parse and apply text filters. In format "aaaaa[,bbbb][,ccccc]" +ImGuiTextFilter::ImGuiTextFilter(const char* default_filter) +{ + if (default_filter) + { + ImStrncpy(InputBuf, default_filter, IM_ARRAYSIZE(InputBuf)); + Build(); + } + else + { + InputBuf[0] = 0; + CountGrep = 0; + } +} + +bool ImGuiTextFilter::Draw(const char* label, float width) +{ + if (width != 0.0f) + ImGui::SetNextItemWidth(width); + bool value_changed = ImGui::InputText(label, InputBuf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(InputBuf)); + if (value_changed) + Build(); + return value_changed; +} + +void ImGuiTextFilter::ImGuiTextRange::split(char separator, ImVector* out) const +{ + out->resize(0); + const char* wb = b; + const char* we = wb; + while (we < e) + { + if (*we == separator) + { + out->push_back(ImGuiTextRange(wb, we)); + wb = we + 1; + } + we++; + } + if (wb != we) + out->push_back(ImGuiTextRange(wb, we)); +} + +void ImGuiTextFilter::Build() +{ + Filters.resize(0); + ImGuiTextRange input_range(InputBuf, InputBuf + strlen(InputBuf)); + input_range.split(',', &Filters); + + CountGrep = 0; + for (int i = 0; i != Filters.Size; i++) + { + ImGuiTextRange& f = Filters[i]; + while (f.b < f.e && ImCharIsBlankA(f.b[0])) + f.b++; + while (f.e > f.b && ImCharIsBlankA(f.e[-1])) + f.e--; + if (f.empty()) + continue; + if (Filters[i].b[0] != '-') + CountGrep += 1; + } +} + +bool ImGuiTextFilter::PassFilter(const char* text, const char* text_end) const +{ + if (Filters.empty()) + return true; + + if (text == NULL) + text = ""; + + for (int i = 0; i != Filters.Size; i++) + { + const ImGuiTextRange& f = Filters[i]; + if (f.empty()) + continue; + if (f.b[0] == '-') + { + // Subtract + if (ImStristr(text, text_end, f.b + 1, f.e) != NULL) + return false; + } + else + { + // Grep + if (ImStristr(text, text_end, f.b, f.e) != NULL) + return true; + } + } + + // Implicit * grep + if (CountGrep == 0) + return true; + + return false; +} + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] ImGuiTextBuffer +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// On some platform vsnprintf() takes va_list by reference and modifies it. +// va_copy is the 'correct' way to copy a va_list but Visual Studio prior to 2013 doesn't have it. +#ifndef va_copy +#if defined(__GNUC__) || defined(__clang__) +#define va_copy(dest, src) __builtin_va_copy(dest, src) +#else +#define va_copy(dest, src) (dest = src) +#endif +#endif + +char ImGuiTextBuffer::EmptyString[1] = { 0 }; + +void ImGuiTextBuffer::append(const char* str, const char* str_end) +{ + int len = str_end ? (int)(str_end - str) : (int)strlen(str); + + // Add zero-terminator the first time + const int write_off = (Buf.Size != 0) ? Buf.Size : 1; + const int needed_sz = write_off + len; + if (write_off + len >= Buf.Capacity) + { + int new_capacity = Buf.Capacity * 2; + Buf.reserve(needed_sz > new_capacity ? needed_sz : new_capacity); + } + + Buf.resize(needed_sz); + memcpy(&Buf[write_off - 1], str, (size_t)len); + Buf[write_off - 1 + len] = 0; +} + +void ImGuiTextBuffer::appendf(const char* fmt, ...) +{ + va_list args; + va_start(args, fmt); + appendfv(fmt, args); + va_end(args); +} + +// Helper: Text buffer for logging/accumulating text +void ImGuiTextBuffer::appendfv(const char* fmt, va_list args) +{ + va_list args_copy; + va_copy(args_copy, args); + + int len = ImFormatStringV(NULL, 0, fmt, args); // FIXME-OPT: could do a first pass write attempt, likely successful on first pass. + if (len <= 0) + { + va_end(args_copy); + return; + } + + // Add zero-terminator the first time + const int write_off = (Buf.Size != 0) ? Buf.Size : 1; + const int needed_sz = write_off + len; + if (write_off + len >= Buf.Capacity) + { + int new_capacity = Buf.Capacity * 2; + Buf.reserve(needed_sz > new_capacity ? needed_sz : new_capacity); + } + + Buf.resize(needed_sz); + ImFormatStringV(&Buf[write_off - 1], (size_t)len + 1, fmt, args_copy); + va_end(args_copy); +} + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] ImGuiListClipper +// This is currently not as flexible/powerful as it should be and really confusing/spaghetti, mostly because we changed +// the API mid-way through development and support two ways to using the clipper, needs some rework (see TODO) +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// FIXME-TABLE: This prevents us from using ImGuiListClipper _inside_ a table cell. +// The problem we have is that without a Begin/End scheme for rows using the clipper is ambiguous. +static bool GetSkipItemForListClipping() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + return (g.CurrentTable ? g.CurrentTable->HostSkipItems : g.CurrentWindow->SkipItems); +} + +// Helper to calculate coarse clipping of large list of evenly sized items. +// NB: Prefer using the ImGuiListClipper higher-level helper if you can! Read comments and instructions there on how those use this sort of pattern. +// NB: 'items_count' is only used to clamp the result, if you don't know your count you can use INT_MAX +void ImGui::CalcListClipping(int items_count, float items_height, int* out_items_display_start, int* out_items_display_end) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + if (g.LogEnabled) + { + // If logging is active, do not perform any clipping + *out_items_display_start = 0; + *out_items_display_end = items_count; + return; + } + if (GetSkipItemForListClipping()) + { + *out_items_display_start = *out_items_display_end = 0; + return; + } + + // We create the union of the ClipRect and the NavScoringRect which at worst should be 1 page away from ClipRect + ImRect unclipped_rect = window->ClipRect; + if (g.NavMoveRequest) + unclipped_rect.Add(g.NavScoringRect); + if (g.NavJustMovedToId && window->NavLastIds[0] == g.NavJustMovedToId) + unclipped_rect.Add(ImRect(window->Pos + window->NavRectRel[0].Min, window->Pos + window->NavRectRel[0].Max)); + + const ImVec2 pos = window->DC.CursorPos; + int start = (int)((unclipped_rect.Min.y - pos.y) / items_height); + int end = (int)((unclipped_rect.Max.y - pos.y) / items_height); + + // When performing a navigation request, ensure we have one item extra in the direction we are moving to + if (g.NavMoveRequest && g.NavMoveClipDir == ImGuiDir_Up) + start--; + if (g.NavMoveRequest && g.NavMoveClipDir == ImGuiDir_Down) + end++; + + start = ImClamp(start, 0, items_count); + end = ImClamp(end + 1, start, items_count); + *out_items_display_start = start; + *out_items_display_end = end; +} + +static void SetCursorPosYAndSetupForPrevLine(float pos_y, float line_height) +{ + // Set cursor position and a few other things so that SetScrollHereY() and Columns() can work when seeking cursor. + // FIXME: It is problematic that we have to do that here, because custom/equivalent end-user code would stumble on the same issue. + // The clipper should probably have a 4th step to display the last item in a regular manner. + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + float off_y = pos_y - window->DC.CursorPos.y; + window->DC.CursorPos.y = pos_y; + window->DC.CursorMaxPos.y = ImMax(window->DC.CursorMaxPos.y, pos_y); + window->DC.CursorPosPrevLine.y = window->DC.CursorPos.y - line_height; // Setting those fields so that SetScrollHereY() can properly function after the end of our clipper usage. + window->DC.PrevLineSize.y = (line_height - g.Style.ItemSpacing.y); // If we end up needing more accurate data (to e.g. use SameLine) we may as well make the clipper have a fourth step to let user process and display the last item in their list. + if (ImGuiOldColumns* columns = window->DC.CurrentColumns) + columns->LineMinY = window->DC.CursorPos.y; // Setting this so that cell Y position are set properly + if (ImGuiTable* table = g.CurrentTable) + { + if (table->IsInsideRow) + ImGui::TableEndRow(table); + table->RowPosY2 = window->DC.CursorPos.y; + const int row_increase = (int)((off_y / line_height) + 0.5f); + //table->CurrentRow += row_increase; // Can't do without fixing TableEndRow() + table->RowBgColorCounter += row_increase; + } +} + +ImGuiListClipper::ImGuiListClipper() +{ + memset(this, 0, sizeof(*this)); + ItemsCount = -1; +} + +ImGuiListClipper::~ImGuiListClipper() +{ + IM_ASSERT(ItemsCount == -1 && "Forgot to call End(), or to Step() until false?"); +} + +// Use case A: Begin() called from constructor with items_height<0, then called again from Step() in StepNo 1 +// Use case B: Begin() called from constructor with items_height>0 +// FIXME-LEGACY: Ideally we should remove the Begin/End functions but they are part of the legacy API we still support. This is why some of the code in Step() calling Begin() and reassign some fields, spaghetti style. +void ImGuiListClipper::Begin(int items_count, float items_height) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + + if (ImGuiTable* table = g.CurrentTable) + if (table->IsInsideRow) + ImGui::TableEndRow(table); + + StartPosY = window->DC.CursorPos.y; + ItemsHeight = items_height; + ItemsCount = items_count; + ItemsFrozen = 0; + StepNo = 0; + DisplayStart = -1; + DisplayEnd = 0; +} + +void ImGuiListClipper::End() +{ + if (ItemsCount < 0) // Already ended + return; + + // In theory here we should assert that ImGui::GetCursorPosY() == StartPosY + DisplayEnd * ItemsHeight, but it feels saner to just seek at the end and not assert/crash the user. + if (ItemsCount < INT_MAX && DisplayStart >= 0) + SetCursorPosYAndSetupForPrevLine(StartPosY + (ItemsCount - ItemsFrozen) * ItemsHeight, ItemsHeight); + ItemsCount = -1; + StepNo = 3; +} + +bool ImGuiListClipper::Step() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + + ImGuiTable* table = g.CurrentTable; + if (table && table->IsInsideRow) + ImGui::TableEndRow(table); + + // No items + if (ItemsCount == 0 || GetSkipItemForListClipping()) + { + End(); + return false; + } + + // Step 0: Let you process the first element (regardless of it being visible or not, so we can measure the element height) + if (StepNo == 0) + { + // While we are in frozen row state, keep displaying items one by one, unclipped + // FIXME: Could be stored as a table-agnostic state. + if (table != NULL && !table->IsUnfrozenRows) + { + DisplayStart = ItemsFrozen; + DisplayEnd = ItemsFrozen + 1; + ItemsFrozen++; + return true; + } + + StartPosY = window->DC.CursorPos.y; + if (ItemsHeight <= 0.0f) + { + // Submit the first item so we can measure its height (generally it is 0..1) + DisplayStart = ItemsFrozen; + DisplayEnd = ItemsFrozen + 1; + StepNo = 1; + return true; + } + + // Already has item height (given by user in Begin): skip to calculating step + DisplayStart = DisplayEnd; + StepNo = 2; + } + + // Step 1: the clipper infer height from first element + if (StepNo == 1) + { + IM_ASSERT(ItemsHeight <= 0.0f); + if (table) + { + const float pos_y1 = table->RowPosY1; // Using this instead of StartPosY to handle clipper straddling the frozen row + const float pos_y2 = table->RowPosY2; // Using this instead of CursorPos.y to take account of tallest cell. + ItemsHeight = pos_y2 - pos_y1; + window->DC.CursorPos.y = pos_y2; + } + else + { + ItemsHeight = window->DC.CursorPos.y - StartPosY; + } + IM_ASSERT(ItemsHeight > 0.0f && "Unable to calculate item height! First item hasn't moved the cursor vertically!"); + StepNo = 2; + } + + // Reached end of list + if (DisplayEnd >= ItemsCount) + { + End(); + return false; + } + + // Step 2: calculate the actual range of elements to display, and position the cursor before the first element + if (StepNo == 2) + { + IM_ASSERT(ItemsHeight > 0.0f); + + int already_submitted = DisplayEnd; + ImGui::CalcListClipping(ItemsCount - already_submitted, ItemsHeight, &DisplayStart, &DisplayEnd); + DisplayStart += already_submitted; + DisplayEnd += already_submitted; + + // Seek cursor + if (DisplayStart > already_submitted) + SetCursorPosYAndSetupForPrevLine(StartPosY + (DisplayStart - ItemsFrozen) * ItemsHeight, ItemsHeight); + + StepNo = 3; + return true; + } + + // Step 3: the clipper validate that we have reached the expected Y position (corresponding to element DisplayEnd), + // Advance the cursor to the end of the list and then returns 'false' to end the loop. + if (StepNo == 3) + { + // Seek cursor + if (ItemsCount < INT_MAX) + SetCursorPosYAndSetupForPrevLine(StartPosY + (ItemsCount - ItemsFrozen) * ItemsHeight, ItemsHeight); // advance cursor + ItemsCount = -1; + return false; + } + + IM_ASSERT(0); + return false; +} + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] STYLING +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +ImGuiStyle& ImGui::GetStyle() +{ + IM_ASSERT(GImGui != NULL && "No current context. Did you call ImGui::CreateContext() and ImGui::SetCurrentContext() ?"); + return GImGui->Style; +} + +ImU32 ImGui::GetColorU32(ImGuiCol idx, float alpha_mul) +{ + ImGuiStyle& style = GImGui->Style; + ImVec4 c = style.Colors[idx]; + c.w *= style.Alpha * alpha_mul; + return ColorConvertFloat4ToU32(c); +} + +ImU32 ImGui::GetColorU32(const ImVec4& col) +{ + ImGuiStyle& style = GImGui->Style; + ImVec4 c = col; + c.w *= style.Alpha; + return ColorConvertFloat4ToU32(c); +} + +const ImVec4& ImGui::GetStyleColorVec4(ImGuiCol idx) +{ + ImGuiStyle& style = GImGui->Style; + return style.Colors[idx]; +} + +ImU32 ImGui::GetColorU32(ImU32 col) +{ + ImGuiStyle& style = GImGui->Style; + if (style.Alpha >= 1.0f) + return col; + ImU32 a = (col & IM_COL32_A_MASK) >> IM_COL32_A_SHIFT; + a = (ImU32)(a * style.Alpha); // We don't need to clamp 0..255 because Style.Alpha is in 0..1 range. + return (col & ~IM_COL32_A_MASK) | (a << IM_COL32_A_SHIFT); +} + +// FIXME: This may incur a round-trip (if the end user got their data from a float4) but eventually we aim to store the in-flight colors as ImU32 +void ImGui::PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol idx, ImU32 col) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiColorMod backup; + backup.Col = idx; + backup.BackupValue = g.Style.Colors[idx]; + g.ColorStack.push_back(backup); + g.Style.Colors[idx] = ColorConvertU32ToFloat4(col); +} + +void ImGui::PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol idx, const ImVec4& col) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiColorMod backup; + backup.Col = idx; + backup.BackupValue = g.Style.Colors[idx]; + g.ColorStack.push_back(backup); + g.Style.Colors[idx] = col; +} + +void ImGui::PopStyleColor(int count) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + while (count > 0) + { + ImGuiColorMod& backup = g.ColorStack.back(); + g.Style.Colors[backup.Col] = backup.BackupValue; + g.ColorStack.pop_back(); + count--; + } +} + +struct ImGuiStyleVarInfo +{ + ImGuiDataType Type; + ImU32 Count; + ImU32 Offset; + void* GetVarPtr(ImGuiStyle* style) const { return (void*)((unsigned char*)style + Offset); } +}; + +static const ImGuiStyleVarInfo GStyleVarInfo[] = +{ + { ImGuiDataType_Float, 1, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImGuiStyle, Alpha) }, // ImGuiStyleVar_Alpha + { ImGuiDataType_Float, 1, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImGuiStyle, DisabledAlpha) }, // ImGuiStyleVar_DisabledAlpha + { ImGuiDataType_Float, 2, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImGuiStyle, WindowPadding) }, // ImGuiStyleVar_WindowPadding + { ImGuiDataType_Float, 1, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImGuiStyle, WindowRounding) }, // ImGuiStyleVar_WindowRounding + { ImGuiDataType_Float, 1, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImGuiStyle, WindowBorderSize) }, // ImGuiStyleVar_WindowBorderSize + { ImGuiDataType_Float, 2, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImGuiStyle, WindowMinSize) }, // ImGuiStyleVar_WindowMinSize + { ImGuiDataType_Float, 2, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImGuiStyle, WindowTitleAlign) }, // ImGuiStyleVar_WindowTitleAlign + { ImGuiDataType_Float, 1, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImGuiStyle, ChildRounding) }, // ImGuiStyleVar_ChildRounding + { ImGuiDataType_Float, 1, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImGuiStyle, ChildBorderSize) }, // ImGuiStyleVar_ChildBorderSize + { ImGuiDataType_Float, 1, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImGuiStyle, PopupRounding) }, // ImGuiStyleVar_PopupRounding + { ImGuiDataType_Float, 1, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImGuiStyle, PopupBorderSize) }, // ImGuiStyleVar_PopupBorderSize + { ImGuiDataType_Float, 2, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImGuiStyle, FramePadding) }, // ImGuiStyleVar_FramePadding + { ImGuiDataType_Float, 1, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImGuiStyle, FrameRounding) }, // ImGuiStyleVar_FrameRounding + { ImGuiDataType_Float, 1, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImGuiStyle, FrameBorderSize) }, // ImGuiStyleVar_FrameBorderSize + { ImGuiDataType_Float, 2, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImGuiStyle, ItemSpacing) }, // ImGuiStyleVar_ItemSpacing + { ImGuiDataType_Float, 2, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImGuiStyle, ItemInnerSpacing) }, // ImGuiStyleVar_ItemInnerSpacing + { ImGuiDataType_Float, 1, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImGuiStyle, IndentSpacing) }, // ImGuiStyleVar_IndentSpacing + { ImGuiDataType_Float, 2, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImGuiStyle, CellPadding) }, // ImGuiStyleVar_CellPadding + { ImGuiDataType_Float, 1, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImGuiStyle, ScrollbarSize) }, // ImGuiStyleVar_ScrollbarSize + { ImGuiDataType_Float, 1, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImGuiStyle, ScrollbarRounding) }, // ImGuiStyleVar_ScrollbarRounding + { ImGuiDataType_Float, 1, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImGuiStyle, GrabMinSize) }, // ImGuiStyleVar_GrabMinSize + { ImGuiDataType_Float, 1, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImGuiStyle, GrabRounding) }, // ImGuiStyleVar_GrabRounding + { ImGuiDataType_Float, 1, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImGuiStyle, TabRounding) }, // ImGuiStyleVar_TabRounding + { ImGuiDataType_Float, 2, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImGuiStyle, ButtonTextAlign) }, // ImGuiStyleVar_ButtonTextAlign + { ImGuiDataType_Float, 2, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImGuiStyle, SelectableTextAlign) }, // ImGuiStyleVar_SelectableTextAlign +}; + +static const ImGuiStyleVarInfo* GetStyleVarInfo(ImGuiStyleVar idx) +{ + IM_ASSERT(idx >= 0 && idx < ImGuiStyleVar_COUNT); + IM_ASSERT(IM_ARRAYSIZE(GStyleVarInfo) == ImGuiStyleVar_COUNT); + return &GStyleVarInfo[idx]; +} + +void ImGui::PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar idx, float val) +{ + const ImGuiStyleVarInfo* var_info = GetStyleVarInfo(idx); + if (var_info->Type == ImGuiDataType_Float && var_info->Count == 1) + { + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + float* pvar = (float*)var_info->GetVarPtr(&g.Style); + g.StyleVarStack.push_back(ImGuiStyleMod(idx, *pvar)); + *pvar = val; + return; + } + IM_ASSERT(0 && "Called PushStyleVar() float variant but variable is not a float!"); +} + +void ImGui::PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar idx, const ImVec2& val) +{ + const ImGuiStyleVarInfo* var_info = GetStyleVarInfo(idx); + if (var_info->Type == ImGuiDataType_Float && var_info->Count == 2) + { + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImVec2* pvar = (ImVec2*)var_info->GetVarPtr(&g.Style); + g.StyleVarStack.push_back(ImGuiStyleMod(idx, *pvar)); + *pvar = val; + return; + } + IM_ASSERT(0 && "Called PushStyleVar() ImVec2 variant but variable is not a ImVec2!"); +} + +void ImGui::PopStyleVar(int count) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + while (count > 0) + { + // We avoid a generic memcpy(data, &backup.Backup.., GDataTypeSize[info->Type] * info->Count), the overhead in Debug is not worth it. + ImGuiStyleMod& backup = g.StyleVarStack.back(); + const ImGuiStyleVarInfo* info = GetStyleVarInfo(backup.VarIdx); + void* data = info->GetVarPtr(&g.Style); + if (info->Type == ImGuiDataType_Float && info->Count == 1) { ((float*)data)[0] = backup.BackupFloat[0]; } + else if (info->Type == ImGuiDataType_Float && info->Count == 2) { ((float*)data)[0] = backup.BackupFloat[0]; ((float*)data)[1] = backup.BackupFloat[1]; } + g.StyleVarStack.pop_back(); + count--; + } +} + +const char* ImGui::GetStyleColorName(ImGuiCol idx) +{ + // Create switch-case from enum with regexp: ImGuiCol_{.*}, --> case ImGuiCol_\1: return "\1"; + switch (idx) + { + case ImGuiCol_Text: return "Text"; + case ImGuiCol_TextDisabled: return "TextDisabled"; + case ImGuiCol_WindowBg: return "WindowBg"; + case ImGuiCol_ChildBg: return "ChildBg"; + case ImGuiCol_PopupBg: return "PopupBg"; + case ImGuiCol_Border: return "Border"; + case ImGuiCol_BorderShadow: return "BorderShadow"; + case ImGuiCol_FrameBg: return "FrameBg"; + case ImGuiCol_FrameBgHovered: return "FrameBgHovered"; + case ImGuiCol_FrameBgActive: return "FrameBgActive"; + case ImGuiCol_TitleBg: return "TitleBg"; + case ImGuiCol_TitleBgActive: return "TitleBgActive"; + case ImGuiCol_TitleBgCollapsed: return "TitleBgCollapsed"; + case ImGuiCol_MenuBarBg: return "MenuBarBg"; + case ImGuiCol_ScrollbarBg: return "ScrollbarBg"; + case ImGuiCol_ScrollbarGrab: return "ScrollbarGrab"; + case ImGuiCol_ScrollbarGrabHovered: return "ScrollbarGrabHovered"; + case ImGuiCol_ScrollbarGrabActive: return "ScrollbarGrabActive"; + case ImGuiCol_CheckMark: return "CheckMark"; + case ImGuiCol_SliderGrab: return "SliderGrab"; + case ImGuiCol_SliderGrabActive: return "SliderGrabActive"; + case ImGuiCol_Button: return "Button"; + case ImGuiCol_ButtonHovered: return "ButtonHovered"; + case ImGuiCol_ButtonActive: return "ButtonActive"; + case ImGuiCol_Header: return "Header"; + case ImGuiCol_HeaderHovered: return "HeaderHovered"; + case ImGuiCol_HeaderActive: return "HeaderActive"; + case ImGuiCol_Separator: return "Separator"; + case ImGuiCol_SeparatorHovered: return "SeparatorHovered"; + case ImGuiCol_SeparatorActive: return "SeparatorActive"; + case ImGuiCol_ResizeGrip: return "ResizeGrip"; + case ImGuiCol_ResizeGripHovered: return "ResizeGripHovered"; + case ImGuiCol_ResizeGripActive: return "ResizeGripActive"; + case ImGuiCol_Tab: return "Tab"; + case ImGuiCol_TabHovered: return "TabHovered"; + case ImGuiCol_TabActive: return "TabActive"; + case ImGuiCol_TabUnfocused: return "TabUnfocused"; + case ImGuiCol_TabUnfocusedActive: return "TabUnfocusedActive"; + case ImGuiCol_PlotLines: return "PlotLines"; + case ImGuiCol_PlotLinesHovered: return "PlotLinesHovered"; + case ImGuiCol_PlotHistogram: return "PlotHistogram"; + case ImGuiCol_PlotHistogramHovered: return "PlotHistogramHovered"; + case ImGuiCol_TableHeaderBg: return "TableHeaderBg"; + case ImGuiCol_TableBorderStrong: return "TableBorderStrong"; + case ImGuiCol_TableBorderLight: return "TableBorderLight"; + case ImGuiCol_TableRowBg: return "TableRowBg"; + case ImGuiCol_TableRowBgAlt: return "TableRowBgAlt"; + case ImGuiCol_TextSelectedBg: return "TextSelectedBg"; + case ImGuiCol_DragDropTarget: return "DragDropTarget"; + case ImGuiCol_NavHighlight: return "NavHighlight"; + case ImGuiCol_NavWindowingHighlight: return "NavWindowingHighlight"; + case ImGuiCol_NavWindowingDimBg: return "NavWindowingDimBg"; + case ImGuiCol_ModalWindowDimBg: return "ModalWindowDimBg"; + } + IM_ASSERT(0); + return "Unknown"; +} + + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] RENDER HELPERS +// Some of those (internal) functions are currently quite a legacy mess - their signature and behavior will change, +// we need a nicer separation between low-level functions and high-level functions relying on the ImGui context. +// Also see imgui_draw.cpp for some more which have been reworked to not rely on ImGui:: context. +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +const char* ImGui::FindRenderedTextEnd(const char* text, const char* text_end) +{ + const char* text_display_end = text; + if (!text_end) + text_end = (const char*)-1; + + while (text_display_end < text_end && *text_display_end != '\0' && (text_display_end[0] != '#' || text_display_end[1] != '#')) + text_display_end++; + return text_display_end; +} + +// Internal ImGui functions to render text +// RenderText***() functions calls ImDrawList::AddText() calls ImBitmapFont::RenderText() +void ImGui::RenderText(ImVec2 pos, const char* text, const char* text_end, bool hide_text_after_hash) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + + // Hide anything after a '##' string + const char* text_display_end; + if (hide_text_after_hash) + { + text_display_end = FindRenderedTextEnd(text, text_end); + } + else + { + if (!text_end) + text_end = text + strlen(text); // FIXME-OPT + text_display_end = text_end; + } + + if (text != text_display_end) + { + window->DrawList->AddText(g.Font, g.FontSize, pos, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text), text, text_display_end); + if (g.LogEnabled) + LogRenderedText(&pos, text, text_display_end); + } +} + +void ImGui::RenderTextWrapped(ImVec2 pos, const char* text, const char* text_end, float wrap_width) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + + if (!text_end) + text_end = text + strlen(text); // FIXME-OPT + + if (text != text_end) + { + window->DrawList->AddText(g.Font, g.FontSize, pos, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text), text, text_end, wrap_width); + if (g.LogEnabled) + LogRenderedText(&pos, text, text_end); + } +} + +// Default clip_rect uses (pos_min,pos_max) +// Handle clipping on CPU immediately (vs typically let the GPU clip the triangles that are overlapping the clipping rectangle edges) +void ImGui::RenderTextClippedEx(ImDrawList* draw_list, const ImVec2& pos_min, const ImVec2& pos_max, const char* text, const char* text_display_end, const ImVec2* text_size_if_known, const ImVec2& align, const ImRect* clip_rect) +{ + // Perform CPU side clipping for single clipped element to avoid using scissor state + ImVec2 pos = pos_min; + const ImVec2 text_size = text_size_if_known ? *text_size_if_known : CalcTextSize(text, text_display_end, false, 0.0f); + + const ImVec2* clip_min = clip_rect ? &clip_rect->Min : &pos_min; + const ImVec2* clip_max = clip_rect ? &clip_rect->Max : &pos_max; + bool need_clipping = (pos.x + text_size.x >= clip_max->x) || (pos.y + text_size.y >= clip_max->y); + if (clip_rect) // If we had no explicit clipping rectangle then pos==clip_min + need_clipping |= (pos.x < clip_min->x) || (pos.y < clip_min->y); + + // Align whole block. We should defer that to the better rendering function when we'll have support for individual line alignment. + if (align.x > 0.0f) pos.x = ImMax(pos.x, pos.x + (pos_max.x - pos.x - text_size.x) * align.x); + if (align.y > 0.0f) pos.y = ImMax(pos.y, pos.y + (pos_max.y - pos.y - text_size.y) * align.y); + + // Render + if (need_clipping) + { + ImVec4 fine_clip_rect(clip_min->x, clip_min->y, clip_max->x, clip_max->y); + draw_list->AddText(NULL, 0.0f, pos, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text), text, text_display_end, 0.0f, &fine_clip_rect); + } + else + { + draw_list->AddText(NULL, 0.0f, pos, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text), text, text_display_end, 0.0f, NULL); + } +} + +void ImGui::RenderTextClipped(const ImVec2& pos_min, const ImVec2& pos_max, const char* text, const char* text_end, const ImVec2* text_size_if_known, const ImVec2& align, const ImRect* clip_rect) +{ + // Hide anything after a '##' string + const char* text_display_end = FindRenderedTextEnd(text, text_end); + const int text_len = (int)(text_display_end - text); + if (text_len == 0) + return; + + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + RenderTextClippedEx(window->DrawList, pos_min, pos_max, text, text_display_end, text_size_if_known, align, clip_rect); + if (g.LogEnabled) + LogRenderedText(&pos_min, text, text_display_end); +} + + +// Another overly complex function until we reorganize everything into a nice all-in-one helper. +// This is made more complex because we have dissociated the layout rectangle (pos_min..pos_max) which define _where_ the ellipsis is, from actual clipping of text and limit of the ellipsis display. +// This is because in the context of tabs we selectively hide part of the text when the Close Button appears, but we don't want the ellipsis to move. +void ImGui::RenderTextEllipsis(ImDrawList* draw_list, const ImVec2& pos_min, const ImVec2& pos_max, float clip_max_x, float ellipsis_max_x, const char* text, const char* text_end_full, const ImVec2* text_size_if_known) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + if (text_end_full == NULL) + text_end_full = FindRenderedTextEnd(text); + const ImVec2 text_size = text_size_if_known ? *text_size_if_known : CalcTextSize(text, text_end_full, false, 0.0f); + + //draw_list->AddLine(ImVec2(pos_max.x, pos_min.y - 4), ImVec2(pos_max.x, pos_max.y + 4), IM_COL32(0, 0, 255, 255)); + //draw_list->AddLine(ImVec2(ellipsis_max_x, pos_min.y-2), ImVec2(ellipsis_max_x, pos_max.y+2), IM_COL32(0, 255, 0, 255)); + //draw_list->AddLine(ImVec2(clip_max_x, pos_min.y), ImVec2(clip_max_x, pos_max.y), IM_COL32(255, 0, 0, 255)); + // FIXME: We could technically remove (last_glyph->AdvanceX - last_glyph->X1) from text_size.x here and save a few pixels. + if (text_size.x > pos_max.x - pos_min.x) + { + // Hello wo... + // | | | + // min max ellipsis_max + // <-> this is generally some padding value + + const ImFont* font = draw_list->_Data->Font; + const float font_size = draw_list->_Data->FontSize; + const char* text_end_ellipsis = NULL; + + ImWchar ellipsis_char = font->EllipsisChar; + int ellipsis_char_count = 1; + if (ellipsis_char == (ImWchar)-1) + { + ellipsis_char = font->DotChar; + ellipsis_char_count = 3; + } + const ImFontGlyph* glyph = font->FindGlyph(ellipsis_char); + + float ellipsis_glyph_width = glyph->X1; // Width of the glyph with no padding on either side + float ellipsis_total_width = ellipsis_glyph_width; // Full width of entire ellipsis + + if (ellipsis_char_count > 1) + { + // Full ellipsis size without free spacing after it. + const float spacing_between_dots = 1.0f * (draw_list->_Data->FontSize / font->FontSize); + ellipsis_glyph_width = glyph->X1 - glyph->X0 + spacing_between_dots; + ellipsis_total_width = ellipsis_glyph_width * (float)ellipsis_char_count - spacing_between_dots; + } + + // We can now claim the space between pos_max.x and ellipsis_max.x + const float text_avail_width = ImMax((ImMax(pos_max.x, ellipsis_max_x) - ellipsis_total_width) - pos_min.x, 1.0f); + float text_size_clipped_x = font->CalcTextSizeA(font_size, text_avail_width, 0.0f, text, text_end_full, &text_end_ellipsis).x; + if (text == text_end_ellipsis && text_end_ellipsis < text_end_full) + { + // Always display at least 1 character if there's no room for character + ellipsis + text_end_ellipsis = text + ImTextCountUtf8BytesFromChar(text, text_end_full); + text_size_clipped_x = font->CalcTextSizeA(font_size, FLT_MAX, 0.0f, text, text_end_ellipsis).x; + } + while (text_end_ellipsis > text && ImCharIsBlankA(text_end_ellipsis[-1])) + { + // Trim trailing space before ellipsis (FIXME: Supporting non-ascii blanks would be nice, for this we need a function to backtrack in UTF-8 text) + text_end_ellipsis--; + text_size_clipped_x -= font->CalcTextSizeA(font_size, FLT_MAX, 0.0f, text_end_ellipsis, text_end_ellipsis + 1).x; // Ascii blanks are always 1 byte + } + + // Render text, render ellipsis + RenderTextClippedEx(draw_list, pos_min, ImVec2(clip_max_x, pos_max.y), text, text_end_ellipsis, &text_size, ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f)); + float ellipsis_x = pos_min.x + text_size_clipped_x; + if (ellipsis_x + ellipsis_total_width <= ellipsis_max_x) + for (int i = 0; i < ellipsis_char_count; i++) + { + font->RenderChar(draw_list, font_size, ImVec2(ellipsis_x, pos_min.y), GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text), ellipsis_char); + ellipsis_x += ellipsis_glyph_width; + } + } + else + { + RenderTextClippedEx(draw_list, pos_min, ImVec2(clip_max_x, pos_max.y), text, text_end_full, &text_size, ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f)); + } + + if (g.LogEnabled) + LogRenderedText(&pos_min, text, text_end_full); +} + +// Render a rectangle shaped with optional rounding and borders +void ImGui::RenderFrame(ImVec2 p_min, ImVec2 p_max, ImU32 fill_col, bool border, float rounding) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(p_min, p_max, fill_col, rounding); + const float border_size = g.Style.FrameBorderSize; + if (border && border_size > 0.0f) + { + window->DrawList->AddRect(p_min + ImVec2(1, 1), p_max + ImVec2(1, 1), GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_BorderShadow), rounding, 0, border_size); + window->DrawList->AddRect(p_min, p_max, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Border), rounding, 0, border_size); + } +} + +void ImGui::RenderFrameBorder(ImVec2 p_min, ImVec2 p_max, float rounding) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + const float border_size = g.Style.FrameBorderSize; + if (border_size > 0.0f) + { + window->DrawList->AddRect(p_min + ImVec2(1, 1), p_max + ImVec2(1, 1), GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_BorderShadow), rounding, 0, border_size); + window->DrawList->AddRect(p_min, p_max, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Border), rounding, 0, border_size); + } +} + +void ImGui::RenderNavHighlight(const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id, ImGuiNavHighlightFlags flags) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + if (id != g.NavId) + return; + if (g.NavDisableHighlight && !(flags & ImGuiNavHighlightFlags_AlwaysDraw)) + return; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + if (window->DC.NavHideHighlightOneFrame) + return; + + float rounding = (flags & ImGuiNavHighlightFlags_NoRounding) ? 0.0f : g.Style.FrameRounding; + ImRect display_rect = bb; + display_rect.ClipWith(window->ClipRect); + if (flags & ImGuiNavHighlightFlags_TypeDefault) + { + const float THICKNESS = 2.0f; + const float DISTANCE = 3.0f + THICKNESS * 0.5f; + display_rect.Expand(ImVec2(DISTANCE, DISTANCE)); + bool fully_visible = window->ClipRect.Contains(display_rect); + if (!fully_visible) + window->DrawList->PushClipRect(display_rect.Min, display_rect.Max); + window->DrawList->AddRect(display_rect.Min + ImVec2(THICKNESS * 0.5f, THICKNESS * 0.5f), display_rect.Max - ImVec2(THICKNESS * 0.5f, THICKNESS * 0.5f), GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_NavHighlight), rounding, 0, THICKNESS); + if (!fully_visible) + window->DrawList->PopClipRect(); + } + if (flags & ImGuiNavHighlightFlags_TypeThin) + { + window->DrawList->AddRect(display_rect.Min, display_rect.Max, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_NavHighlight), rounding, 0, 1.0f); + } +} + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] MAIN CODE (most of the code! lots of stuff, needs tidying up!) +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// ImGuiWindow is mostly a dumb struct. It merely has a constructor and a few helper methods +ImGuiWindow::ImGuiWindow(ImGuiContext* context, const char* name) : DrawListInst(NULL) +{ + memset(this, 0, sizeof(*this)); + Name = ImStrdup(name); + NameBufLen = (int)strlen(name) + 1; + ID = ImHashStr(name); + IDStack.push_back(ID); + MoveId = GetID("#MOVE"); + ScrollTarget = ImVec2(FLT_MAX, FLT_MAX); + ScrollTargetCenterRatio = ImVec2(0.5f, 0.5f); + AutoFitFramesX = AutoFitFramesY = -1; + AutoPosLastDirection = ImGuiDir_None; + SetWindowPosAllowFlags = SetWindowSizeAllowFlags = SetWindowCollapsedAllowFlags = ImGuiCond_Always | ImGuiCond_Once | ImGuiCond_FirstUseEver | ImGuiCond_Appearing; + SetWindowPosVal = SetWindowPosPivot = ImVec2(FLT_MAX, FLT_MAX); + LastFrameActive = -1; + LastTimeActive = -1.0f; + FontWindowScale = 1.0f; + SettingsOffset = -1; + DrawList = &DrawListInst; + DrawList->_Data = &context->DrawListSharedData; + DrawList->_OwnerName = Name; +} + +ImGuiWindow::~ImGuiWindow() +{ + IM_ASSERT(DrawList == &DrawListInst); + IM_DELETE(Name); + ColumnsStorage.clear_destruct(); +} + +ImGuiID ImGuiWindow::GetID(const char* str, const char* str_end) +{ + ImGuiID seed = IDStack.back(); + ImGuiID id = ImHashStr(str, str_end ? (str_end - str) : 0, seed); + ImGui::KeepAliveID(id); +#ifdef IMGUI_ENABLE_TEST_ENGINE + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + IMGUI_TEST_ENGINE_ID_INFO2(id, ImGuiDataType_String, str, str_end); +#endif + return id; +} + +ImGuiID ImGuiWindow::GetID(const void* ptr) +{ + ImGuiID seed = IDStack.back(); + ImGuiID id = ImHashData(&ptr, sizeof(void*), seed); + ImGui::KeepAliveID(id); +#ifdef IMGUI_ENABLE_TEST_ENGINE + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + IMGUI_TEST_ENGINE_ID_INFO(id, ImGuiDataType_Pointer, ptr); +#endif + return id; +} + +ImGuiID ImGuiWindow::GetID(int n) +{ + ImGuiID seed = IDStack.back(); + ImGuiID id = ImHashData(&n, sizeof(n), seed); + ImGui::KeepAliveID(id); +#ifdef IMGUI_ENABLE_TEST_ENGINE + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + IMGUI_TEST_ENGINE_ID_INFO(id, ImGuiDataType_S32, (intptr_t)n); +#endif + return id; +} + +ImGuiID ImGuiWindow::GetIDNoKeepAlive(const char* str, const char* str_end) +{ + ImGuiID seed = IDStack.back(); + ImGuiID id = ImHashStr(str, str_end ? (str_end - str) : 0, seed); +#ifdef IMGUI_ENABLE_TEST_ENGINE + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + IMGUI_TEST_ENGINE_ID_INFO2(id, ImGuiDataType_String, str, str_end); +#endif + return id; +} + +ImGuiID ImGuiWindow::GetIDNoKeepAlive(const void* ptr) +{ + ImGuiID seed = IDStack.back(); + ImGuiID id = ImHashData(&ptr, sizeof(void*), seed); +#ifdef IMGUI_ENABLE_TEST_ENGINE + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + IMGUI_TEST_ENGINE_ID_INFO(id, ImGuiDataType_Pointer, ptr); +#endif + return id; +} + +ImGuiID ImGuiWindow::GetIDNoKeepAlive(int n) +{ + ImGuiID seed = IDStack.back(); + ImGuiID id = ImHashData(&n, sizeof(n), seed); +#ifdef IMGUI_ENABLE_TEST_ENGINE + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + IMGUI_TEST_ENGINE_ID_INFO(id, ImGuiDataType_S32, (intptr_t)n); +#endif + return id; +} + +// This is only used in rare/specific situations to manufacture an ID out of nowhere. +ImGuiID ImGuiWindow::GetIDFromRectangle(const ImRect& r_abs) +{ + ImGuiID seed = IDStack.back(); + const int r_rel[4] = { (int)(r_abs.Min.x - Pos.x), (int)(r_abs.Min.y - Pos.y), (int)(r_abs.Max.x - Pos.x), (int)(r_abs.Max.y - Pos.y) }; + ImGuiID id = ImHashData(&r_rel, sizeof(r_rel), seed); + ImGui::KeepAliveID(id); + return id; +} + +static void SetCurrentWindow(ImGuiWindow* window) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + g.CurrentWindow = window; + g.CurrentTable = window && window->DC.CurrentTableIdx != -1 ? g.Tables.GetByIndex(window->DC.CurrentTableIdx) : NULL; + if (window) + g.FontSize = g.DrawListSharedData.FontSize = window->CalcFontSize(); +} + +void ImGui::GcCompactTransientMiscBuffers() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + g.ItemFlagsStack.clear(); + g.GroupStack.clear(); + TableGcCompactSettings(); +} + +// Free up/compact internal window buffers, we can use this when a window becomes unused. +// Not freed: +// - ImGuiWindow, ImGuiWindowSettings, Name, StateStorage, ColumnsStorage (may hold useful data) +// This should have no noticeable visual effect. When the window reappear however, expect new allocation/buffer growth/copy cost. +void ImGui::GcCompactTransientWindowBuffers(ImGuiWindow* window) +{ + window->MemoryCompacted = true; + window->MemoryDrawListIdxCapacity = window->DrawList->IdxBuffer.Capacity; + window->MemoryDrawListVtxCapacity = window->DrawList->VtxBuffer.Capacity; + window->IDStack.clear(); + window->DrawList->_ClearFreeMemory(); + window->DC.ChildWindows.clear(); + window->DC.ItemWidthStack.clear(); + window->DC.TextWrapPosStack.clear(); +} + +void ImGui::GcAwakeTransientWindowBuffers(ImGuiWindow* window) +{ + // We stored capacity of the ImDrawList buffer to reduce growth-caused allocation/copy when awakening. + // The other buffers tends to amortize much faster. + window->MemoryCompacted = false; + window->DrawList->IdxBuffer.reserve(window->MemoryDrawListIdxCapacity); + window->DrawList->VtxBuffer.reserve(window->MemoryDrawListVtxCapacity); + window->MemoryDrawListIdxCapacity = window->MemoryDrawListVtxCapacity = 0; +} + +void ImGui::SetActiveID(ImGuiID id, ImGuiWindow* window) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + g.ActiveIdIsJustActivated = (g.ActiveId != id); + if (g.ActiveIdIsJustActivated) + { + g.ActiveIdTimer = 0.0f; + g.ActiveIdHasBeenPressedBefore = false; + g.ActiveIdHasBeenEditedBefore = false; + g.ActiveIdMouseButton = -1; + if (id != 0) + { + g.LastActiveId = id; + g.LastActiveIdTimer = 0.0f; + } + } + g.ActiveId = id; + g.ActiveIdAllowOverlap = false; + g.ActiveIdNoClearOnFocusLoss = false; + g.ActiveIdWindow = window; + g.ActiveIdHasBeenEditedThisFrame = false; + if (id) + { + g.ActiveIdIsAlive = id; + g.ActiveIdSource = (g.NavActivateId == id || g.NavInputId == id || g.NavJustTabbedId == id || g.NavJustMovedToId == id) ? ImGuiInputSource_Nav : ImGuiInputSource_Mouse; + } + + // Clear declaration of inputs claimed by the widget + // (Please note that this is WIP and not all keys/inputs are thoroughly declared by all widgets yet) + g.ActiveIdUsingMouseWheel = false; + g.ActiveIdUsingNavDirMask = 0x00; + g.ActiveIdUsingNavInputMask = 0x00; + g.ActiveIdUsingKeyInputMask = 0x00; +} + +void ImGui::ClearActiveID() +{ + SetActiveID(0, NULL); // g.ActiveId = 0; +} + +void ImGui::SetHoveredID(ImGuiID id) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + g.HoveredId = id; + g.HoveredIdAllowOverlap = false; + g.HoveredIdUsingMouseWheel = false; + if (id != 0 && g.HoveredIdPreviousFrame != id) + g.HoveredIdTimer = g.HoveredIdNotActiveTimer = 0.0f; +} + +ImGuiID ImGui::GetHoveredID() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + return g.HoveredId ? g.HoveredId : g.HoveredIdPreviousFrame; +} + +void ImGui::KeepAliveID(ImGuiID id) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + if (g.ActiveId == id) + g.ActiveIdIsAlive = id; + if (g.ActiveIdPreviousFrame == id) + g.ActiveIdPreviousFrameIsAlive = true; +} + +void ImGui::MarkItemEdited(ImGuiID id) +{ + // This marking is solely to be able to provide info for IsItemDeactivatedAfterEdit(). + // ActiveId might have been released by the time we call this (as in the typical press/release button behavior) but still need need to fill the data. + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + IM_ASSERT(g.ActiveId == id || g.ActiveId == 0 || g.DragDropActive); + IM_UNUSED(id); // Avoid unused variable warnings when asserts are compiled out. + //IM_ASSERT(g.CurrentWindow->DC.LastItemId == id); + g.ActiveIdHasBeenEditedThisFrame = true; + g.ActiveIdHasBeenEditedBefore = true; + g.LastItemData.StatusFlags |= ImGuiItemStatusFlags_Edited; +} + +static inline bool IsWindowContentHoverable(ImGuiWindow* window, ImGuiHoveredFlags flags) +{ + // An active popup disable hovering on other windows (apart from its own children) + // FIXME-OPT: This could be cached/stored within the window. + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + if (g.NavWindow) + if (ImGuiWindow* focused_root_window = g.NavWindow->RootWindow) + if (focused_root_window->WasActive && focused_root_window != window->RootWindow) + { + // For the purpose of those flags we differentiate "standard popup" from "modal popup" + // NB: The order of those two tests is important because Modal windows are also Popups. + if (focused_root_window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Modal) + return false; + if ((focused_root_window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup) && !(flags & ImGuiHoveredFlags_AllowWhenBlockedByPopup)) + return false; + } + return true; +} + +// This is roughly matching the behavior of internal-facing ItemHoverable() +// - we allow hovering to be true when ActiveId==window->MoveID, so that clicking on non-interactive items such as a Text() item still returns true with IsItemHovered() +// - this should work even for non-interactive items that have no ID, so we cannot use LastItemId +bool ImGui::IsItemHovered(ImGuiHoveredFlags flags) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + if (g.NavDisableMouseHover && !g.NavDisableHighlight) + { + if ((g.LastItemData.InFlags & ImGuiItemFlags_Disabled) && !(flags & ImGuiHoveredFlags_AllowWhenDisabled)) + return false; + return IsItemFocused(); + } + + // Test for bounding box overlap, as updated as ItemAdd() + ImGuiItemStatusFlags status_flags = g.LastItemData.StatusFlags; + if (!(status_flags & ImGuiItemStatusFlags_HoveredRect)) + return false; + IM_ASSERT((flags & (ImGuiHoveredFlags_RootWindow | ImGuiHoveredFlags_ChildWindows)) == 0); // Flags not supported by this function + + // Test if we are hovering the right window (our window could be behind another window) + // [2021/03/02] Reworked / reverted the revert, finally. Note we want e.g. BeginGroup/ItemAdd/EndGroup to work as well. (#3851) + // [2017/10/16] Reverted commit 344d48be3 and testing RootWindow instead. I believe it is correct to NOT test for RootWindow but this leaves us unable + // to use IsItemHovered() after EndChild() itself. Until a solution is found I believe reverting to the test from 2017/09/27 is safe since this was + // the test that has been running for a long while. + if (g.HoveredWindow != window && (status_flags & ImGuiItemStatusFlags_HoveredWindow) == 0) + if ((flags & ImGuiHoveredFlags_AllowWhenOverlapped) == 0) + return false; + + // Test if another item is active (e.g. being dragged) + if ((flags & ImGuiHoveredFlags_AllowWhenBlockedByActiveItem) == 0) + if (g.ActiveId != 0 && g.ActiveId != g.LastItemData.ID && !g.ActiveIdAllowOverlap && g.ActiveId != window->MoveId) + return false; + + // Test if interactions on this window are blocked by an active popup or modal. + // The ImGuiHoveredFlags_AllowWhenBlockedByPopup flag will be tested here. + if (!IsWindowContentHoverable(window, flags)) + return false; + + // Test if the item is disabled + if ((g.LastItemData.InFlags & ImGuiItemFlags_Disabled) && !(flags & ImGuiHoveredFlags_AllowWhenDisabled)) + return false; + + // Special handling for calling after Begin() which represent the title bar or tab. + // When the window is collapsed (SkipItems==true) that last item will never be overwritten so we need to detect the case. + if (g.LastItemData.ID == window->MoveId && window->WriteAccessed) + return false; + return true; +} + +// Internal facing ItemHoverable() used when submitting widgets. Differs slightly from IsItemHovered(). +bool ImGui::ItemHoverable(const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + if (g.HoveredId != 0 && g.HoveredId != id && !g.HoveredIdAllowOverlap) + return false; + + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + if (g.HoveredWindow != window) + return false; + if (g.ActiveId != 0 && g.ActiveId != id && !g.ActiveIdAllowOverlap) + return false; + if (!IsMouseHoveringRect(bb.Min, bb.Max)) + return false; + if (g.NavDisableMouseHover) + return false; + if (!IsWindowContentHoverable(window, ImGuiHoveredFlags_None)) + { + g.HoveredIdDisabled = true; + return false; + } + + // We exceptionally allow this function to be called with id==0 to allow using it for easy high-level + // hover test in widgets code. We could also decide to split this function is two. + if (id != 0) + SetHoveredID(id); + + // When disabled we'll return false but still set HoveredId + ImGuiItemFlags item_flags = (g.LastItemData.ID == id ? g.LastItemData.InFlags : g.CurrentItemFlags); + if (item_flags & ImGuiItemFlags_Disabled) + { + // Release active id if turning disabled + if (g.ActiveId == id) + ClearActiveID(); + g.HoveredIdDisabled = true; + return false; + } + + if (id != 0) + { + // [DEBUG] Item Picker tool! + // We perform the check here because SetHoveredID() is not frequently called (1~ time a frame), making + // the cost of this tool near-zero. We can get slightly better call-stack and support picking non-hovered + // items if we perform the test in ItemAdd(), but that would incur a small runtime cost. + // #define IMGUI_DEBUG_TOOL_ITEM_PICKER_EX in imconfig.h if you want this check to also be performed in ItemAdd(). + if (g.DebugItemPickerActive && g.HoveredIdPreviousFrame == id) + GetForegroundDrawList()->AddRect(bb.Min, bb.Max, IM_COL32(255, 255, 0, 255)); + if (g.DebugItemPickerBreakId == id) + IM_DEBUG_BREAK(); + } + + return true; +} + +bool ImGui::IsClippedEx(const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id, bool clip_even_when_logged) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + if (!bb.Overlaps(window->ClipRect)) + if (id == 0 || (id != g.ActiveId && id != g.NavId)) + if (clip_even_when_logged || !g.LogEnabled) + return true; + return false; +} + +// Called by ItemAdd() +// Process TAB/Shift+TAB. Be mindful that this function may _clear_ the ActiveID when tabbing out. +void ImGui::ItemFocusable(ImGuiWindow* window, ImGuiID id) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + IM_ASSERT(id != 0 && id == g.LastItemData.ID); + + // Increment counters + // FIXME: ImGuiItemFlags_Disabled should disable more. + const bool is_tab_stop = (g.LastItemData.InFlags & (ImGuiItemFlags_NoTabStop | ImGuiItemFlags_Disabled)) == 0; + window->DC.FocusCounterRegular++; + if (is_tab_stop) + { + window->DC.FocusCounterTabStop++; + if (g.NavId == id) + g.NavIdTabCounter = window->DC.FocusCounterTabStop; + } + + // Process TAB/Shift-TAB to tab *OUT* of the currently focused item. + // (Note that we can always TAB out of a widget that doesn't allow tabbing in) + if (g.ActiveId == id && g.TabFocusPressed && !IsActiveIdUsingKey(ImGuiKey_Tab) && g.TabFocusRequestNextWindow == NULL) + { + g.TabFocusRequestNextWindow = window; + g.TabFocusRequestNextCounterTabStop = window->DC.FocusCounterTabStop + (g.IO.KeyShift ? (is_tab_stop ? -1 : 0) : +1); // Modulo on index will be applied at the end of frame once we've got the total counter of items. + } + + // Handle focus requests + if (g.TabFocusRequestCurrWindow == window) + { + if (window->DC.FocusCounterRegular == g.TabFocusRequestCurrCounterRegular) + { + g.LastItemData.StatusFlags |= ImGuiItemStatusFlags_FocusedByCode; + return; + } + if (is_tab_stop && window->DC.FocusCounterTabStop == g.TabFocusRequestCurrCounterTabStop) + { + g.NavJustTabbedId = id; + g.LastItemData.StatusFlags |= ImGuiItemStatusFlags_FocusedByTabbing; + return; + } + + // If another item is about to be focused, we clear our own active id + if (g.ActiveId == id) + ClearActiveID(); + } +} + +float ImGui::CalcWrapWidthForPos(const ImVec2& pos, float wrap_pos_x) +{ + if (wrap_pos_x < 0.0f) + return 0.0f; + + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + if (wrap_pos_x == 0.0f) + { + // We could decide to setup a default wrapping max point for auto-resizing windows, + // or have auto-wrap (with unspecified wrapping pos) behave as a ContentSize extending function? + //if (window->Hidden && (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize)) + // wrap_pos_x = ImMax(window->WorkRect.Min.x + g.FontSize * 10.0f, window->WorkRect.Max.x); + //else + wrap_pos_x = window->WorkRect.Max.x; + } + else if (wrap_pos_x > 0.0f) + { + wrap_pos_x += window->Pos.x - window->Scroll.x; // wrap_pos_x is provided is window local space + } + + return ImMax(wrap_pos_x - pos.x, 1.0f); +} + +// IM_ALLOC() == ImGui::MemAlloc() +void* ImGui::MemAlloc(size_t size) +{ + if (ImGuiContext* ctx = GImGui) + ctx->IO.MetricsActiveAllocations++; + return (*GImAllocatorAllocFunc)(size, GImAllocatorUserData); +} + +// IM_FREE() == ImGui::MemFree() +void ImGui::MemFree(void* ptr) +{ + if (ptr) + if (ImGuiContext* ctx = GImGui) + ctx->IO.MetricsActiveAllocations--; + return (*GImAllocatorFreeFunc)(ptr, GImAllocatorUserData); +} + +const char* ImGui::GetClipboardText() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + return g.IO.GetClipboardTextFn ? g.IO.GetClipboardTextFn(g.IO.ClipboardUserData) : ""; +} + +void ImGui::SetClipboardText(const char* text) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + if (g.IO.SetClipboardTextFn) + g.IO.SetClipboardTextFn(g.IO.ClipboardUserData, text); +} + +const char* ImGui::GetVersion() +{ + return IMGUI_VERSION; +} + +// Internal state access - if you want to share Dear ImGui state between modules (e.g. DLL) or allocate it yourself +// Note that we still point to some static data and members (such as GFontAtlas), so the state instance you end up using will point to the static data within its module +ImGuiContext* ImGui::GetCurrentContext() +{ + return GImGui; +} + +void ImGui::SetCurrentContext(ImGuiContext* ctx) +{ +#ifdef IMGUI_SET_CURRENT_CONTEXT_FUNC + IMGUI_SET_CURRENT_CONTEXT_FUNC(ctx); // For custom thread-based hackery you may want to have control over this. +#else + GImGui = ctx; +#endif +} + +void ImGui::SetAllocatorFunctions(ImGuiMemAllocFunc alloc_func, ImGuiMemFreeFunc free_func, void* user_data) +{ + GImAllocatorAllocFunc = alloc_func; + GImAllocatorFreeFunc = free_func; + GImAllocatorUserData = user_data; +} + +// This is provided to facilitate copying allocators from one static/DLL boundary to another (e.g. retrieve default allocator of your executable address space) +void ImGui::GetAllocatorFunctions(ImGuiMemAllocFunc* p_alloc_func, ImGuiMemFreeFunc* p_free_func, void** p_user_data) +{ + *p_alloc_func = GImAllocatorAllocFunc; + *p_free_func = GImAllocatorFreeFunc; + *p_user_data = GImAllocatorUserData; +} + +ImGuiContext* ImGui::CreateContext(ImFontAtlas* shared_font_atlas) +{ + ImGuiContext* ctx = IM_NEW(ImGuiContext)(shared_font_atlas); + if (GImGui == NULL) + SetCurrentContext(ctx); + Initialize(ctx); + return ctx; +} + +void ImGui::DestroyContext(ImGuiContext* ctx) +{ + if (ctx == NULL) + ctx = GImGui; + Shutdown(ctx); + if (GImGui == ctx) + SetCurrentContext(NULL); + IM_DELETE(ctx); +} + +// No specific ordering/dependency support, will see as needed +ImGuiID ImGui::AddContextHook(ImGuiContext* ctx, const ImGuiContextHook* hook) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *ctx; + IM_ASSERT(hook->Callback != NULL && hook->HookId == 0 && hook->Type != ImGuiContextHookType_PendingRemoval_); + g.Hooks.push_back(*hook); + g.Hooks.back().HookId = ++g.HookIdNext; + return g.HookIdNext; +} + +// Deferred removal, avoiding issue with changing vector while iterating it +void ImGui::RemoveContextHook(ImGuiContext* ctx, ImGuiID hook_id) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *ctx; + IM_ASSERT(hook_id != 0); + for (int n = 0; n < g.Hooks.Size; n++) + if (g.Hooks[n].HookId == hook_id) + g.Hooks[n].Type = ImGuiContextHookType_PendingRemoval_; +} + +// Call context hooks (used by e.g. test engine) +// We assume a small number of hooks so all stored in same array +void ImGui::CallContextHooks(ImGuiContext* ctx, ImGuiContextHookType hook_type) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *ctx; + for (int n = 0; n < g.Hooks.Size; n++) + if (g.Hooks[n].Type == hook_type) + g.Hooks[n].Callback(&g, &g.Hooks[n]); +} + +ImGuiIO& ImGui::GetIO() +{ + IM_ASSERT(GImGui != NULL && "No current context. Did you call ImGui::CreateContext() and ImGui::SetCurrentContext() ?"); + return GImGui->IO; +} + +// Pass this to your backend rendering function! Valid after Render() and until the next call to NewFrame() +ImDrawData* ImGui::GetDrawData() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiViewportP* viewport = g.Viewports[0]; + return viewport->DrawDataP.Valid ? &viewport->DrawDataP : NULL; +} + +double ImGui::GetTime() +{ + return GImGui->Time; +} + +int ImGui::GetFrameCount() +{ + return GImGui->FrameCount; +} + +static ImDrawList* GetViewportDrawList(ImGuiViewportP* viewport, size_t drawlist_no, const char* drawlist_name) +{ + // Create the draw list on demand, because they are not frequently used for all viewports + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + IM_ASSERT(drawlist_no < IM_ARRAYSIZE(viewport->DrawLists)); + ImDrawList* draw_list = viewport->DrawLists[drawlist_no]; + if (draw_list == NULL) + { + draw_list = IM_NEW(ImDrawList)(&g.DrawListSharedData); + draw_list->_OwnerName = drawlist_name; + viewport->DrawLists[drawlist_no] = draw_list; + } + + // Our ImDrawList system requires that there is always a command + if (viewport->DrawListsLastFrame[drawlist_no] != g.FrameCount) + { + draw_list->_ResetForNewFrame(); + draw_list->PushTextureID(g.IO.Fonts->TexID); + draw_list->PushClipRect(viewport->Pos, viewport->Pos + viewport->Size, false); + viewport->DrawListsLastFrame[drawlist_no] = g.FrameCount; + } + return draw_list; +} + +ImDrawList* ImGui::GetBackgroundDrawList(ImGuiViewport* viewport) +{ + return GetViewportDrawList((ImGuiViewportP*)viewport, 0, "##Background"); +} + +ImDrawList* ImGui::GetBackgroundDrawList() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + return GetBackgroundDrawList(g.Viewports[0]); +} + +ImDrawList* ImGui::GetForegroundDrawList(ImGuiViewport* viewport) +{ + return GetViewportDrawList((ImGuiViewportP*)viewport, 1, "##Foreground"); +} + +ImDrawList* ImGui::GetForegroundDrawList() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + return GetForegroundDrawList(g.Viewports[0]); +} + +ImDrawListSharedData* ImGui::GetDrawListSharedData() +{ + return &GImGui->DrawListSharedData; +} + +void ImGui::StartMouseMovingWindow(ImGuiWindow* window) +{ + // Set ActiveId even if the _NoMove flag is set. Without it, dragging away from a window with _NoMove would activate hover on other windows. + // We _also_ call this when clicking in a window empty space when io.ConfigWindowsMoveFromTitleBarOnly is set, but clear g.MovingWindow afterward. + // This is because we want ActiveId to be set even when the window is not permitted to move. + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + FocusWindow(window); + SetActiveID(window->MoveId, window); + g.NavDisableHighlight = true; + g.ActiveIdClickOffset = g.IO.MouseClickedPos[0] - window->RootWindow->Pos; + g.ActiveIdNoClearOnFocusLoss = true; + SetActiveIdUsingNavAndKeys(); + + bool can_move_window = true; + if ((window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoMove) || (window->RootWindow->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoMove)) + can_move_window = false; + if (can_move_window) + g.MovingWindow = window; +} + +// Handle mouse moving window +// Note: moving window with the navigation keys (Square + d-pad / CTRL+TAB + Arrows) are processed in NavUpdateWindowing() +// FIXME: We don't have strong guarantee that g.MovingWindow stay synched with g.ActiveId == g.MovingWindow->MoveId. +// This is currently enforced by the fact that BeginDragDropSource() is setting all g.ActiveIdUsingXXXX flags to inhibit navigation inputs, +// but if we should more thoroughly test cases where g.ActiveId or g.MovingWindow gets changed and not the other. +void ImGui::UpdateMouseMovingWindowNewFrame() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + if (g.MovingWindow != NULL) + { + // We actually want to move the root window. g.MovingWindow == window we clicked on (could be a child window). + // We track it to preserve Focus and so that generally ActiveIdWindow == MovingWindow and ActiveId == MovingWindow->MoveId for consistency. + KeepAliveID(g.ActiveId); + IM_ASSERT(g.MovingWindow && g.MovingWindow->RootWindow); + ImGuiWindow* moving_window = g.MovingWindow->RootWindow; + if (g.IO.MouseDown[0] && IsMousePosValid(&g.IO.MousePos)) + { + ImVec2 pos = g.IO.MousePos - g.ActiveIdClickOffset; + if (moving_window->Pos.x != pos.x || moving_window->Pos.y != pos.y) + { + MarkIniSettingsDirty(moving_window); + SetWindowPos(moving_window, pos, ImGuiCond_Always); + } + FocusWindow(g.MovingWindow); + } + else + { + g.MovingWindow = NULL; + ClearActiveID(); + } + } + else + { + // When clicking/dragging from a window that has the _NoMove flag, we still set the ActiveId in order to prevent hovering others. + if (g.ActiveIdWindow && g.ActiveIdWindow->MoveId == g.ActiveId) + { + KeepAliveID(g.ActiveId); + if (!g.IO.MouseDown[0]) + ClearActiveID(); + } + } +} + +// Initiate moving window when clicking on empty space or title bar. +// Handle left-click and right-click focus. +void ImGui::UpdateMouseMovingWindowEndFrame() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + if (g.ActiveId != 0 || g.HoveredId != 0) + return; + + // Unless we just made a window/popup appear + if (g.NavWindow && g.NavWindow->Appearing) + return; + + // Click on empty space to focus window and start moving + // (after we're done with all our widgets) + if (g.IO.MouseClicked[0]) + { + // Handle the edge case of a popup being closed while clicking in its empty space. + // If we try to focus it, FocusWindow() > ClosePopupsOverWindow() will accidentally close any parent popups because they are not linked together any more. + ImGuiWindow* root_window = g.HoveredWindow ? g.HoveredWindow->RootWindow : NULL; + const bool is_closed_popup = root_window && (root_window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup) && !IsPopupOpen(root_window->PopupId, ImGuiPopupFlags_AnyPopupLevel); + + if (root_window != NULL && !is_closed_popup) + { + StartMouseMovingWindow(g.HoveredWindow); //-V595 + + // Cancel moving if clicked outside of title bar + if (g.IO.ConfigWindowsMoveFromTitleBarOnly && !(root_window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar)) + if (!root_window->TitleBarRect().Contains(g.IO.MouseClickedPos[0])) + g.MovingWindow = NULL; + + // Cancel moving if clicked over an item which was disabled or inhibited by popups (note that we know HoveredId == 0 already) + if (g.HoveredIdDisabled) + g.MovingWindow = NULL; + } + else if (root_window == NULL && g.NavWindow != NULL && GetTopMostPopupModal() == NULL) + { + // Clicking on void disable focus + FocusWindow(NULL); + } + } + + // With right mouse button we close popups without changing focus based on where the mouse is aimed + // Instead, focus will be restored to the window under the bottom-most closed popup. + // (The left mouse button path calls FocusWindow on the hovered window, which will lead NewFrame->ClosePopupsOverWindow to trigger) + if (g.IO.MouseClicked[1]) + { + // Find the top-most window between HoveredWindow and the top-most Modal Window. + // This is where we can trim the popup stack. + ImGuiWindow* modal = GetTopMostPopupModal(); + bool hovered_window_above_modal = g.HoveredWindow && IsWindowAbove(g.HoveredWindow, modal); + ClosePopupsOverWindow(hovered_window_above_modal ? g.HoveredWindow : modal, true); + } +} + +static bool IsWindowActiveAndVisible(ImGuiWindow* window) +{ + return (window->Active) && (!window->Hidden); +} + +static void ImGui::UpdateMouseInputs() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + + // Round mouse position to avoid spreading non-rounded position (e.g. UpdateManualResize doesn't support them well) + if (IsMousePosValid(&g.IO.MousePos)) + g.IO.MousePos = g.LastValidMousePos = ImFloor(g.IO.MousePos); + + // If mouse just appeared or disappeared (usually denoted by -FLT_MAX components) we cancel out movement in MouseDelta + if (IsMousePosValid(&g.IO.MousePos) && IsMousePosValid(&g.IO.MousePosPrev)) + g.IO.MouseDelta = g.IO.MousePos - g.IO.MousePosPrev; + else + g.IO.MouseDelta = ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f); + if (g.IO.MouseDelta.x != 0.0f || g.IO.MouseDelta.y != 0.0f) + g.NavDisableMouseHover = false; + + g.IO.MousePosPrev = g.IO.MousePos; + for (int i = 0; i < IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.IO.MouseDown); i++) + { + g.IO.MouseClicked[i] = g.IO.MouseDown[i] && g.IO.MouseDownDuration[i] < 0.0f; + g.IO.MouseReleased[i] = !g.IO.MouseDown[i] && g.IO.MouseDownDuration[i] >= 0.0f; + g.IO.MouseDownDurationPrev[i] = g.IO.MouseDownDuration[i]; + g.IO.MouseDownDuration[i] = g.IO.MouseDown[i] ? (g.IO.MouseDownDuration[i] < 0.0f ? 0.0f : g.IO.MouseDownDuration[i] + g.IO.DeltaTime) : -1.0f; + g.IO.MouseDoubleClicked[i] = false; + if (g.IO.MouseClicked[i]) + { + if ((float)(g.Time - g.IO.MouseClickedTime[i]) < g.IO.MouseDoubleClickTime) + { + ImVec2 delta_from_click_pos = IsMousePosValid(&g.IO.MousePos) ? (g.IO.MousePos - g.IO.MouseClickedPos[i]) : ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f); + if (ImLengthSqr(delta_from_click_pos) < g.IO.MouseDoubleClickMaxDist * g.IO.MouseDoubleClickMaxDist) + g.IO.MouseDoubleClicked[i] = true; + g.IO.MouseClickedTime[i] = -g.IO.MouseDoubleClickTime * 2.0f; // Mark as "old enough" so the third click isn't turned into a double-click + } + else + { + g.IO.MouseClickedTime[i] = g.Time; + } + g.IO.MouseClickedPos[i] = g.IO.MousePos; + g.IO.MouseDownWasDoubleClick[i] = g.IO.MouseDoubleClicked[i]; + g.IO.MouseDragMaxDistanceAbs[i] = ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f); + g.IO.MouseDragMaxDistanceSqr[i] = 0.0f; + } + else if (g.IO.MouseDown[i]) + { + // Maintain the maximum distance we reaching from the initial click position, which is used with dragging threshold + ImVec2 delta_from_click_pos = IsMousePosValid(&g.IO.MousePos) ? (g.IO.MousePos - g.IO.MouseClickedPos[i]) : ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f); + g.IO.MouseDragMaxDistanceSqr[i] = ImMax(g.IO.MouseDragMaxDistanceSqr[i], ImLengthSqr(delta_from_click_pos)); + g.IO.MouseDragMaxDistanceAbs[i].x = ImMax(g.IO.MouseDragMaxDistanceAbs[i].x, delta_from_click_pos.x < 0.0f ? -delta_from_click_pos.x : delta_from_click_pos.x); + g.IO.MouseDragMaxDistanceAbs[i].y = ImMax(g.IO.MouseDragMaxDistanceAbs[i].y, delta_from_click_pos.y < 0.0f ? -delta_from_click_pos.y : delta_from_click_pos.y); + } + if (!g.IO.MouseDown[i] && !g.IO.MouseReleased[i]) + g.IO.MouseDownWasDoubleClick[i] = false; + if (g.IO.MouseClicked[i]) // Clicking any mouse button reactivate mouse hovering which may have been deactivated by gamepad/keyboard navigation + g.NavDisableMouseHover = false; + } +} + +static void StartLockWheelingWindow(ImGuiWindow* window) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + if (g.WheelingWindow == window) + return; + g.WheelingWindow = window; + g.WheelingWindowRefMousePos = g.IO.MousePos; + g.WheelingWindowTimer = WINDOWS_MOUSE_WHEEL_SCROLL_LOCK_TIMER; +} + +void ImGui::UpdateMouseWheel() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + + // Reset the locked window if we move the mouse or after the timer elapses + if (g.WheelingWindow != NULL) + { + g.WheelingWindowTimer -= g.IO.DeltaTime; + if (IsMousePosValid() && ImLengthSqr(g.IO.MousePos - g.WheelingWindowRefMousePos) > g.IO.MouseDragThreshold * g.IO.MouseDragThreshold) + g.WheelingWindowTimer = 0.0f; + if (g.WheelingWindowTimer <= 0.0f) + { + g.WheelingWindow = NULL; + g.WheelingWindowTimer = 0.0f; + } + } + + if (g.IO.MouseWheel == 0.0f && g.IO.MouseWheelH == 0.0f) + return; + + if ((g.ActiveId != 0 && g.ActiveIdUsingMouseWheel) || (g.HoveredIdPreviousFrame != 0 && g.HoveredIdPreviousFrameUsingMouseWheel)) + return; + + ImGuiWindow* window = g.WheelingWindow ? g.WheelingWindow : g.HoveredWindow; + if (!window || window->Collapsed) + return; + + // Zoom / Scale window + // FIXME-OBSOLETE: This is an old feature, it still works but pretty much nobody is using it and may be best redesigned. + if (g.IO.MouseWheel != 0.0f && g.IO.KeyCtrl && g.IO.FontAllowUserScaling) + { + StartLockWheelingWindow(window); + const float new_font_scale = ImClamp(window->FontWindowScale + g.IO.MouseWheel * 0.10f, 0.50f, 2.50f); + const float scale = new_font_scale / window->FontWindowScale; + window->FontWindowScale = new_font_scale; + if (window == window->RootWindow) + { + const ImVec2 offset = window->Size * (1.0f - scale) * (g.IO.MousePos - window->Pos) / window->Size; + SetWindowPos(window, window->Pos + offset, 0); + window->Size = ImFloor(window->Size * scale); + window->SizeFull = ImFloor(window->SizeFull * scale); + } + return; + } + + // Mouse wheel scrolling + // If a child window has the ImGuiWindowFlags_NoScrollWithMouse flag, we give a chance to scroll its parent + if (g.IO.KeyCtrl) + return; + + // As a standard behavior holding SHIFT while using Vertical Mouse Wheel triggers Horizontal scroll instead + // (we avoid doing it on OSX as it the OS input layer handles this already) + const bool swap_axis = g.IO.KeyShift && !g.IO.ConfigMacOSXBehaviors; + const float wheel_y = swap_axis ? 0.0f : g.IO.MouseWheel; + const float wheel_x = swap_axis ? g.IO.MouseWheel : g.IO.MouseWheelH; + + // Vertical Mouse Wheel scrolling + if (wheel_y != 0.0f) + { + StartLockWheelingWindow(window); + while ((window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow) && ((window->ScrollMax.y == 0.0f) || ((window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoScrollWithMouse) && !(window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoMouseInputs)))) + window = window->ParentWindow; + if (!(window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoScrollWithMouse) && !(window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoMouseInputs)) + { + float max_step = window->InnerRect.GetHeight() * 0.67f; + float scroll_step = ImFloor(ImMin(5 * window->CalcFontSize(), max_step)); + SetScrollY(window, window->Scroll.y - wheel_y * scroll_step); + } + } + + // Horizontal Mouse Wheel scrolling, or Vertical Mouse Wheel w/ Shift held + if (wheel_x != 0.0f) + { + StartLockWheelingWindow(window); + while ((window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow) && ((window->ScrollMax.x == 0.0f) || ((window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoScrollWithMouse) && !(window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoMouseInputs)))) + window = window->ParentWindow; + if (!(window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoScrollWithMouse) && !(window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoMouseInputs)) + { + float max_step = window->InnerRect.GetWidth() * 0.67f; + float scroll_step = ImFloor(ImMin(2 * window->CalcFontSize(), max_step)); + SetScrollX(window, window->Scroll.x - wheel_x * scroll_step); + } + } +} + +void ImGui::UpdateTabFocus() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + + // Pressing TAB activate widget focus + g.TabFocusPressed = (g.NavWindow && g.NavWindow->Active && !(g.NavWindow->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoNavInputs) && !g.IO.KeyCtrl && IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_Tab)); + if (g.ActiveId == 0 && g.TabFocusPressed) + { + // - This path is only taken when no widget are active/tabbed-into yet. + // Subsequent tabbing will be processed by FocusableItemRegister() + // - Note that SetKeyboardFocusHere() sets the Next fields mid-frame. To be consistent we also + // manipulate the Next fields here even though they will be turned into Curr fields below. + g.TabFocusRequestNextWindow = g.NavWindow; + g.TabFocusRequestNextCounterRegular = INT_MAX; + if (g.NavId != 0 && g.NavIdTabCounter != INT_MAX) + g.TabFocusRequestNextCounterTabStop = g.NavIdTabCounter + (g.IO.KeyShift ? -1 : 0); + else + g.TabFocusRequestNextCounterTabStop = g.IO.KeyShift ? -1 : 0; + } + + // Turn queued focus request into current one + g.TabFocusRequestCurrWindow = NULL; + g.TabFocusRequestCurrCounterRegular = g.TabFocusRequestCurrCounterTabStop = INT_MAX; + if (g.TabFocusRequestNextWindow != NULL) + { + ImGuiWindow* window = g.TabFocusRequestNextWindow; + g.TabFocusRequestCurrWindow = window; + if (g.TabFocusRequestNextCounterRegular != INT_MAX && window->DC.FocusCounterRegular != -1) + g.TabFocusRequestCurrCounterRegular = ImModPositive(g.TabFocusRequestNextCounterRegular, window->DC.FocusCounterRegular + 1); + if (g.TabFocusRequestNextCounterTabStop != INT_MAX && window->DC.FocusCounterTabStop != -1) + g.TabFocusRequestCurrCounterTabStop = ImModPositive(g.TabFocusRequestNextCounterTabStop, window->DC.FocusCounterTabStop + 1); + g.TabFocusRequestNextWindow = NULL; + g.TabFocusRequestNextCounterRegular = g.TabFocusRequestNextCounterTabStop = INT_MAX; + } + + g.NavIdTabCounter = INT_MAX; +} + +// The reason this is exposed in imgui_internal.h is: on touch-based system that don't have hovering, we want to dispatch inputs to the right target (imgui vs imgui+app) +void ImGui::UpdateHoveredWindowAndCaptureFlags() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + g.WindowsHoverPadding = ImMax(g.Style.TouchExtraPadding, ImVec2(WINDOWS_HOVER_PADDING, WINDOWS_HOVER_PADDING)); + + // Find the window hovered by mouse: + // - Child windows can extend beyond the limit of their parent so we need to derive HoveredRootWindow from HoveredWindow. + // - When moving a window we can skip the search, which also conveniently bypasses the fact that window->WindowRectClipped is lagging as this point of the frame. + // - We also support the moved window toggling the NoInputs flag after moving has started in order to be able to detect windows below it, which is useful for e.g. docking mechanisms. + bool clear_hovered_windows = false; + FindHoveredWindow(); + + // Modal windows prevents mouse from hovering behind them. + ImGuiWindow* modal_window = GetTopMostPopupModal(); + if (modal_window && g.HoveredWindow && !IsWindowChildOf(g.HoveredWindow->RootWindow, modal_window)) + clear_hovered_windows = true; + + // Disabled mouse? + if (g.IO.ConfigFlags & ImGuiConfigFlags_NoMouse) + clear_hovered_windows = true; + + // We track click ownership. When clicked outside of a window the click is owned by the application and won't report hovering nor request capture even while dragging over our windows afterward. + int mouse_earliest_button_down = -1; + bool mouse_any_down = false; + for (int i = 0; i < IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.IO.MouseDown); i++) + { + if (g.IO.MouseClicked[i]) + g.IO.MouseDownOwned[i] = (g.HoveredWindow != NULL) || (g.OpenPopupStack.Size > 0); + mouse_any_down |= g.IO.MouseDown[i]; + if (g.IO.MouseDown[i]) + if (mouse_earliest_button_down == -1 || g.IO.MouseClickedTime[i] < g.IO.MouseClickedTime[mouse_earliest_button_down]) + mouse_earliest_button_down = i; + } + const bool mouse_avail_to_imgui = (mouse_earliest_button_down == -1) || g.IO.MouseDownOwned[mouse_earliest_button_down]; + + // If mouse was first clicked outside of ImGui bounds we also cancel out hovering. + // FIXME: For patterns of drag and drop across OS windows, we may need to rework/remove this test (first committed 311c0ca9 on 2015/02) + const bool mouse_dragging_extern_payload = g.DragDropActive && (g.DragDropSourceFlags & ImGuiDragDropFlags_SourceExtern) != 0; + if (!mouse_avail_to_imgui && !mouse_dragging_extern_payload) + clear_hovered_windows = true; + + if (clear_hovered_windows) + g.HoveredWindow = g.HoveredWindowUnderMovingWindow = NULL; + + // Update io.WantCaptureMouse for the user application (true = dispatch mouse info to imgui, false = dispatch mouse info to Dear ImGui + app) + if (g.WantCaptureMouseNextFrame != -1) + g.IO.WantCaptureMouse = (g.WantCaptureMouseNextFrame != 0); + else + g.IO.WantCaptureMouse = (mouse_avail_to_imgui && (g.HoveredWindow != NULL || mouse_any_down)) || (g.OpenPopupStack.Size > 0); + + // Update io.WantCaptureKeyboard for the user application (true = dispatch keyboard info to imgui, false = dispatch keyboard info to Dear ImGui + app) + if (g.WantCaptureKeyboardNextFrame != -1) + g.IO.WantCaptureKeyboard = (g.WantCaptureKeyboardNextFrame != 0); + else + g.IO.WantCaptureKeyboard = (g.ActiveId != 0) || (modal_window != NULL); + if (g.IO.NavActive && (g.IO.ConfigFlags & ImGuiConfigFlags_NavEnableKeyboard) && !(g.IO.ConfigFlags & ImGuiConfigFlags_NavNoCaptureKeyboard)) + g.IO.WantCaptureKeyboard = true; + + // Update io.WantTextInput flag, this is to allow systems without a keyboard (e.g. mobile, hand-held) to show a software keyboard if possible + g.IO.WantTextInput = (g.WantTextInputNextFrame != -1) ? (g.WantTextInputNextFrame != 0) : false; +} + +ImGuiKeyModFlags ImGui::GetMergedKeyModFlags() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiKeyModFlags key_mod_flags = ImGuiKeyModFlags_None; + if (g.IO.KeyCtrl) { key_mod_flags |= ImGuiKeyModFlags_Ctrl; } + if (g.IO.KeyShift) { key_mod_flags |= ImGuiKeyModFlags_Shift; } + if (g.IO.KeyAlt) { key_mod_flags |= ImGuiKeyModFlags_Alt; } + if (g.IO.KeySuper) { key_mod_flags |= ImGuiKeyModFlags_Super; } + return key_mod_flags; +} + +void ImGui::NewFrame() +{ + IM_ASSERT(GImGui != NULL && "No current context. Did you call ImGui::CreateContext() and ImGui::SetCurrentContext() ?"); + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + + // Remove pending delete hooks before frame start. + // This deferred removal avoid issues of removal while iterating the hook vector + for (int n = g.Hooks.Size - 1; n >= 0; n--) + if (g.Hooks[n].Type == ImGuiContextHookType_PendingRemoval_) + g.Hooks.erase(&g.Hooks[n]); + + CallContextHooks(&g, ImGuiContextHookType_NewFramePre); + + // Check and assert for various common IO and Configuration mistakes + ErrorCheckNewFrameSanityChecks(); + + // Load settings on first frame, save settings when modified (after a delay) + UpdateSettings(); + + g.Time += g.IO.DeltaTime; + g.WithinFrameScope = true; + g.FrameCount += 1; + g.TooltipOverrideCount = 0; + g.WindowsActiveCount = 0; + g.MenusIdSubmittedThisFrame.resize(0); + + // Calculate frame-rate for the user, as a purely luxurious feature + g.FramerateSecPerFrameAccum += g.IO.DeltaTime - g.FramerateSecPerFrame[g.FramerateSecPerFrameIdx]; + g.FramerateSecPerFrame[g.FramerateSecPerFrameIdx] = g.IO.DeltaTime; + g.FramerateSecPerFrameIdx = (g.FramerateSecPerFrameIdx + 1) % IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.FramerateSecPerFrame); + g.FramerateSecPerFrameCount = ImMin(g.FramerateSecPerFrameCount + 1, IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.FramerateSecPerFrame)); + g.IO.Framerate = (g.FramerateSecPerFrameAccum > 0.0f) ? (1.0f / (g.FramerateSecPerFrameAccum / (float)g.FramerateSecPerFrameCount)) : FLT_MAX; + + UpdateViewportsNewFrame(); + + // Setup current font and draw list shared data + g.IO.Fonts->Locked = true; + SetCurrentFont(GetDefaultFont()); + IM_ASSERT(g.Font->IsLoaded()); + ImRect virtual_space(FLT_MAX, FLT_MAX, -FLT_MAX, -FLT_MAX); + for (int n = 0; n < g.Viewports.Size; n++) + virtual_space.Add(g.Viewports[n]->GetMainRect()); + g.DrawListSharedData.ClipRectFullscreen = virtual_space.ToVec4(); + g.DrawListSharedData.CurveTessellationTol = g.Style.CurveTessellationTol; + g.DrawListSharedData.SetCircleTessellationMaxError(g.Style.CircleTessellationMaxError); + g.DrawListSharedData.InitialFlags = ImDrawListFlags_None; + if (g.Style.AntiAliasedLines) + g.DrawListSharedData.InitialFlags |= ImDrawListFlags_AntiAliasedLines; + if (g.Style.AntiAliasedLinesUseTex && !(g.Font->ContainerAtlas->Flags & ImFontAtlasFlags_NoBakedLines)) + g.DrawListSharedData.InitialFlags |= ImDrawListFlags_AntiAliasedLinesUseTex; + if (g.Style.AntiAliasedFill) + g.DrawListSharedData.InitialFlags |= ImDrawListFlags_AntiAliasedFill; + if (g.IO.BackendFlags & ImGuiBackendFlags_RendererHasVtxOffset) + g.DrawListSharedData.InitialFlags |= ImDrawListFlags_AllowVtxOffset; + + // Mark rendering data as invalid to prevent user who may have a handle on it to use it. + for (int n = 0; n < g.Viewports.Size; n++) + { + ImGuiViewportP* viewport = g.Viewports[n]; + viewport->DrawDataP.Clear(); + } + + // Drag and drop keep the source ID alive so even if the source disappear our state is consistent + if (g.DragDropActive && g.DragDropPayload.SourceId == g.ActiveId) + KeepAliveID(g.DragDropPayload.SourceId); + + // Update HoveredId data + if (!g.HoveredIdPreviousFrame) + g.HoveredIdTimer = 0.0f; + if (!g.HoveredIdPreviousFrame || (g.HoveredId && g.ActiveId == g.HoveredId)) + g.HoveredIdNotActiveTimer = 0.0f; + if (g.HoveredId) + g.HoveredIdTimer += g.IO.DeltaTime; + if (g.HoveredId && g.ActiveId != g.HoveredId) + g.HoveredIdNotActiveTimer += g.IO.DeltaTime; + g.HoveredIdPreviousFrame = g.HoveredId; + g.HoveredIdPreviousFrameUsingMouseWheel = g.HoveredIdUsingMouseWheel; + g.HoveredId = 0; + g.HoveredIdAllowOverlap = false; + g.HoveredIdUsingMouseWheel = false; + g.HoveredIdDisabled = false; + + // Update ActiveId data (clear reference to active widget if the widget isn't alive anymore) + if (g.ActiveIdIsAlive != g.ActiveId && g.ActiveIdPreviousFrame == g.ActiveId && g.ActiveId != 0) + ClearActiveID(); + if (g.ActiveId) + g.ActiveIdTimer += g.IO.DeltaTime; + g.LastActiveIdTimer += g.IO.DeltaTime; + g.ActiveIdPreviousFrame = g.ActiveId; + g.ActiveIdPreviousFrameWindow = g.ActiveIdWindow; + g.ActiveIdPreviousFrameHasBeenEditedBefore = g.ActiveIdHasBeenEditedBefore; + g.ActiveIdIsAlive = 0; + g.ActiveIdHasBeenEditedThisFrame = false; + g.ActiveIdPreviousFrameIsAlive = false; + g.ActiveIdIsJustActivated = false; + if (g.TempInputId != 0 && g.ActiveId != g.TempInputId) + g.TempInputId = 0; + if (g.ActiveId == 0) + { + g.ActiveIdUsingNavDirMask = 0x00; + g.ActiveIdUsingNavInputMask = 0x00; + g.ActiveIdUsingKeyInputMask = 0x00; + } + + // Drag and drop + g.DragDropAcceptIdPrev = g.DragDropAcceptIdCurr; + g.DragDropAcceptIdCurr = 0; + g.DragDropAcceptIdCurrRectSurface = FLT_MAX; + g.DragDropWithinSource = false; + g.DragDropWithinTarget = false; + g.DragDropHoldJustPressedId = 0; + + // Update keyboard input state + // Synchronize io.KeyMods with individual modifiers io.KeyXXX bools + g.IO.KeyMods = GetMergedKeyModFlags(); + memcpy(g.IO.KeysDownDurationPrev, g.IO.KeysDownDuration, sizeof(g.IO.KeysDownDuration)); + for (int i = 0; i < IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.IO.KeysDown); i++) + g.IO.KeysDownDuration[i] = g.IO.KeysDown[i] ? (g.IO.KeysDownDuration[i] < 0.0f ? 0.0f : g.IO.KeysDownDuration[i] + g.IO.DeltaTime) : -1.0f; + + // Update gamepad/keyboard navigation + NavUpdate(); + + // Update mouse input state + UpdateMouseInputs(); + + // Find hovered window + // (needs to be before UpdateMouseMovingWindowNewFrame so we fill g.HoveredWindowUnderMovingWindow on the mouse release frame) + UpdateHoveredWindowAndCaptureFlags(); + + // Handle user moving window with mouse (at the beginning of the frame to avoid input lag or sheering) + UpdateMouseMovingWindowNewFrame(); + + // Background darkening/whitening + if (GetTopMostPopupModal() != NULL || (g.NavWindowingTarget != NULL && g.NavWindowingHighlightAlpha > 0.0f)) + g.DimBgRatio = ImMin(g.DimBgRatio + g.IO.DeltaTime * 6.0f, 1.0f); + else + g.DimBgRatio = ImMax(g.DimBgRatio - g.IO.DeltaTime * 10.0f, 0.0f); + + g.MouseCursor = ImGuiMouseCursor_Arrow; + g.WantCaptureMouseNextFrame = g.WantCaptureKeyboardNextFrame = g.WantTextInputNextFrame = -1; + g.PlatformImePos = ImVec2(1.0f, 1.0f); // OS Input Method Editor showing on top-left of our window by default + + // Mouse wheel scrolling, scale + UpdateMouseWheel(); + + // Update legacy TAB focus + UpdateTabFocus(); + + // Mark all windows as not visible and compact unused memory. + IM_ASSERT(g.WindowsFocusOrder.Size <= g.Windows.Size); + const float memory_compact_start_time = (g.GcCompactAll || g.IO.ConfigMemoryCompactTimer < 0.0f) ? FLT_MAX : (float)g.Time - g.IO.ConfigMemoryCompactTimer; + for (int i = 0; i != g.Windows.Size; i++) + { + ImGuiWindow* window = g.Windows[i]; + window->WasActive = window->Active; + window->BeginCount = 0; + window->Active = false; + window->WriteAccessed = false; + + // Garbage collect transient buffers of recently unused windows + if (!window->WasActive && !window->MemoryCompacted && window->LastTimeActive < memory_compact_start_time) + GcCompactTransientWindowBuffers(window); + } + + // Garbage collect transient buffers of recently unused tables + for (int i = 0; i < g.TablesLastTimeActive.Size; i++) + if (g.TablesLastTimeActive[i] >= 0.0f && g.TablesLastTimeActive[i] < memory_compact_start_time) + TableGcCompactTransientBuffers(g.Tables.GetByIndex(i)); + for (int i = 0; i < g.TablesTempDataStack.Size; i++) + if (g.TablesTempDataStack[i].LastTimeActive >= 0.0f && g.TablesTempDataStack[i].LastTimeActive < memory_compact_start_time) + TableGcCompactTransientBuffers(&g.TablesTempDataStack[i]); + if (g.GcCompactAll) + GcCompactTransientMiscBuffers(); + g.GcCompactAll = false; + + // Closing the focused window restore focus to the first active root window in descending z-order + if (g.NavWindow && !g.NavWindow->WasActive) + FocusTopMostWindowUnderOne(NULL, NULL); + + // No window should be open at the beginning of the frame. + // But in order to allow the user to call NewFrame() multiple times without calling Render(), we are doing an explicit clear. + g.CurrentWindowStack.resize(0); + g.BeginPopupStack.resize(0); + g.ItemFlagsStack.resize(0); + g.ItemFlagsStack.push_back(ImGuiItemFlags_None); + g.GroupStack.resize(0); + + // [DEBUG] Item picker tool - start with DebugStartItemPicker() - useful to visually select an item and break into its call-stack. + UpdateDebugToolItemPicker(); + + // Create implicit/fallback window - which we will only render it if the user has added something to it. + // We don't use "Debug" to avoid colliding with user trying to create a "Debug" window with custom flags. + // This fallback is particularly important as it avoid ImGui:: calls from crashing. + g.WithinFrameScopeWithImplicitWindow = true; + SetNextWindowSize(ImVec2(400, 400), ImGuiCond_FirstUseEver); + Begin("Debug##Default"); + IM_ASSERT(g.CurrentWindow->IsFallbackWindow == true); + + CallContextHooks(&g, ImGuiContextHookType_NewFramePost); +} + +// [DEBUG] Item picker tool - start with DebugStartItemPicker() - useful to visually select an item and break into its call-stack. +void ImGui::UpdateDebugToolItemPicker() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + g.DebugItemPickerBreakId = 0; + if (g.DebugItemPickerActive) + { + const ImGuiID hovered_id = g.HoveredIdPreviousFrame; + SetMouseCursor(ImGuiMouseCursor_Hand); + if (IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_Escape)) + g.DebugItemPickerActive = false; + if (IsMouseClicked(0) && hovered_id) + { + g.DebugItemPickerBreakId = hovered_id; + g.DebugItemPickerActive = false; + } + SetNextWindowBgAlpha(0.60f); + BeginTooltip(); + Text("HoveredId: 0x%08X", hovered_id); + Text("Press ESC to abort picking."); + TextColored(GetStyleColorVec4(hovered_id ? ImGuiCol_Text : ImGuiCol_TextDisabled), "Click to break in debugger!"); + EndTooltip(); + } +} + +void ImGui::Initialize(ImGuiContext* context) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *context; + IM_ASSERT(!g.Initialized && !g.SettingsLoaded); + + // Add .ini handle for ImGuiWindow type + { + ImGuiSettingsHandler ini_handler; + ini_handler.TypeName = "Window"; + ini_handler.TypeHash = ImHashStr("Window"); + ini_handler.ClearAllFn = WindowSettingsHandler_ClearAll; + ini_handler.ReadOpenFn = WindowSettingsHandler_ReadOpen; + ini_handler.ReadLineFn = WindowSettingsHandler_ReadLine; + ini_handler.ApplyAllFn = WindowSettingsHandler_ApplyAll; + ini_handler.WriteAllFn = WindowSettingsHandler_WriteAll; + g.SettingsHandlers.push_back(ini_handler); + } + + // Add .ini handle for ImGuiTable type + TableSettingsInstallHandler(context); + + // Create default viewport + ImGuiViewportP* viewport = IM_NEW(ImGuiViewportP)(); + g.Viewports.push_back(viewport); + +#ifdef IMGUI_HAS_DOCK +#endif + + g.Initialized = true; +} + +// This function is merely here to free heap allocations. +void ImGui::Shutdown(ImGuiContext* context) +{ + // The fonts atlas can be used prior to calling NewFrame(), so we clear it even if g.Initialized is FALSE (which would happen if we never called NewFrame) + ImGuiContext& g = *context; + if (g.IO.Fonts && g.FontAtlasOwnedByContext) + { + g.IO.Fonts->Locked = false; + IM_DELETE(g.IO.Fonts); + } + g.IO.Fonts = NULL; + + // Cleanup of other data are conditional on actually having initialized Dear ImGui. + if (!g.Initialized) + return; + + // Save settings (unless we haven't attempted to load them: CreateContext/DestroyContext without a call to NewFrame shouldn't save an empty file) + if (g.SettingsLoaded && g.IO.IniFilename != NULL) + { + ImGuiContext* backup_context = GImGui; + SetCurrentContext(&g); + SaveIniSettingsToDisk(g.IO.IniFilename); + SetCurrentContext(backup_context); + } + + CallContextHooks(&g, ImGuiContextHookType_Shutdown); + + // Clear everything else + g.Windows.clear_delete(); + g.WindowsFocusOrder.clear(); + g.WindowsTempSortBuffer.clear(); + g.CurrentWindow = NULL; + g.CurrentWindowStack.clear(); + g.WindowsById.Clear(); + g.NavWindow = NULL; + g.HoveredWindow = g.HoveredWindowUnderMovingWindow = NULL; + g.ActiveIdWindow = g.ActiveIdPreviousFrameWindow = NULL; + g.MovingWindow = NULL; + g.ColorStack.clear(); + g.StyleVarStack.clear(); + g.FontStack.clear(); + g.OpenPopupStack.clear(); + g.BeginPopupStack.clear(); + + g.Viewports.clear_delete(); + + g.TabBars.Clear(); + g.CurrentTabBarStack.clear(); + g.ShrinkWidthBuffer.clear(); + + g.Tables.Clear(); + g.TablesTempDataStack.clear_destruct(); + g.DrawChannelsTempMergeBuffer.clear(); + + g.ClipboardHandlerData.clear(); + g.MenusIdSubmittedThisFrame.clear(); + g.InputTextState.ClearFreeMemory(); + + g.SettingsWindows.clear(); + g.SettingsHandlers.clear(); + + if (g.LogFile) + { +#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_TTY_FUNCTIONS + if (g.LogFile != stdout) +#endif + ImFileClose(g.LogFile); + g.LogFile = NULL; + } + g.LogBuffer.clear(); + + g.Initialized = false; +} + +// FIXME: Add a more explicit sort order in the window structure. +static int IMGUI_CDECL ChildWindowComparer(const void* lhs, const void* rhs) +{ + const ImGuiWindow* const a = *(const ImGuiWindow* const *)lhs; + const ImGuiWindow* const b = *(const ImGuiWindow* const *)rhs; + if (int d = (a->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup) - (b->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup)) + return d; + if (int d = (a->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Tooltip) - (b->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Tooltip)) + return d; + return (a->BeginOrderWithinParent - b->BeginOrderWithinParent); +} + +static void AddWindowToSortBuffer(ImVector* out_sorted_windows, ImGuiWindow* window) +{ + out_sorted_windows->push_back(window); + if (window->Active) + { + int count = window->DC.ChildWindows.Size; + if (count > 1) + ImQsort(window->DC.ChildWindows.Data, (size_t)count, sizeof(ImGuiWindow*), ChildWindowComparer); + for (int i = 0; i < count; i++) + { + ImGuiWindow* child = window->DC.ChildWindows[i]; + if (child->Active) + AddWindowToSortBuffer(out_sorted_windows, child); + } + } +} + +static void AddDrawListToDrawData(ImVector* out_list, ImDrawList* draw_list) +{ + // Remove trailing command if unused. + // Technically we could return directly instead of popping, but this make things looks neat in Metrics/Debugger window as well. + draw_list->_PopUnusedDrawCmd(); + if (draw_list->CmdBuffer.Size == 0) + return; + + // Draw list sanity check. Detect mismatch between PrimReserve() calls and incrementing _VtxCurrentIdx, _VtxWritePtr etc. + // May trigger for you if you are using PrimXXX functions incorrectly. + IM_ASSERT(draw_list->VtxBuffer.Size == 0 || draw_list->_VtxWritePtr == draw_list->VtxBuffer.Data + draw_list->VtxBuffer.Size); + IM_ASSERT(draw_list->IdxBuffer.Size == 0 || draw_list->_IdxWritePtr == draw_list->IdxBuffer.Data + draw_list->IdxBuffer.Size); + if (!(draw_list->Flags & ImDrawListFlags_AllowVtxOffset)) + IM_ASSERT((int)draw_list->_VtxCurrentIdx == draw_list->VtxBuffer.Size); + + // Check that draw_list doesn't use more vertices than indexable (default ImDrawIdx = unsigned short = 2 bytes = 64K vertices per ImDrawList = per window) + // If this assert triggers because you are drawing lots of stuff manually: + // - First, make sure you are coarse clipping yourself and not trying to draw many things outside visible bounds. + // Be mindful that the ImDrawList API doesn't filter vertices. Use the Metrics/Debugger window to inspect draw list contents. + // - If you want large meshes with more than 64K vertices, you can either: + // (A) Handle the ImDrawCmd::VtxOffset value in your renderer backend, and set 'io.BackendFlags |= ImGuiBackendFlags_RendererHasVtxOffset'. + // Most example backends already support this from 1.71. Pre-1.71 backends won't. + // Some graphics API such as GL ES 1/2 don't have a way to offset the starting vertex so it is not supported for them. + // (B) Or handle 32-bit indices in your renderer backend, and uncomment '#define ImDrawIdx unsigned int' line in imconfig.h. + // Most example backends already support this. For example, the OpenGL example code detect index size at compile-time: + // glDrawElements(GL_TRIANGLES, (GLsizei)pcmd->ElemCount, sizeof(ImDrawIdx) == 2 ? GL_UNSIGNED_SHORT : GL_UNSIGNED_INT, idx_buffer_offset); + // Your own engine or render API may use different parameters or function calls to specify index sizes. + // 2 and 4 bytes indices are generally supported by most graphics API. + // - If for some reason neither of those solutions works for you, a workaround is to call BeginChild()/EndChild() before reaching + // the 64K limit to split your draw commands in multiple draw lists. + if (sizeof(ImDrawIdx) == 2) + IM_ASSERT(draw_list->_VtxCurrentIdx < (1 << 16) && "Too many vertices in ImDrawList using 16-bit indices. Read comment above"); + + out_list->push_back(draw_list); +} + +static void AddWindowToDrawData(ImGuiWindow* window, int layer) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiViewportP* viewport = g.Viewports[0]; + g.IO.MetricsRenderWindows++; + AddDrawListToDrawData(&viewport->DrawDataBuilder.Layers[layer], window->DrawList); + for (int i = 0; i < window->DC.ChildWindows.Size; i++) + { + ImGuiWindow* child = window->DC.ChildWindows[i]; + if (IsWindowActiveAndVisible(child)) // Clipped children may have been marked not active + AddWindowToDrawData(child, layer); + } +} + +// Layer is locked for the root window, however child windows may use a different viewport (e.g. extruding menu) +static void AddRootWindowToDrawData(ImGuiWindow* window) +{ + int layer = (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Tooltip) ? 1 : 0; + AddWindowToDrawData(window, layer); +} + +void ImDrawDataBuilder::FlattenIntoSingleLayer() +{ + int n = Layers[0].Size; + int size = n; + for (int i = 1; i < IM_ARRAYSIZE(Layers); i++) + size += Layers[i].Size; + Layers[0].resize(size); + for (int layer_n = 1; layer_n < IM_ARRAYSIZE(Layers); layer_n++) + { + ImVector& layer = Layers[layer_n]; + if (layer.empty()) + continue; + memcpy(&Layers[0][n], &layer[0], layer.Size * sizeof(ImDrawList*)); + n += layer.Size; + layer.resize(0); + } +} + +static void SetupViewportDrawData(ImGuiViewportP* viewport, ImVector* draw_lists) +{ + ImGuiIO& io = ImGui::GetIO(); + ImDrawData* draw_data = &viewport->DrawDataP; + draw_data->Valid = true; + draw_data->CmdLists = (draw_lists->Size > 0) ? draw_lists->Data : NULL; + draw_data->CmdListsCount = draw_lists->Size; + draw_data->TotalVtxCount = draw_data->TotalIdxCount = 0; + draw_data->DisplayPos = viewport->Pos; + draw_data->DisplaySize = viewport->Size; + draw_data->FramebufferScale = io.DisplayFramebufferScale; + for (int n = 0; n < draw_lists->Size; n++) + { + draw_data->TotalVtxCount += draw_lists->Data[n]->VtxBuffer.Size; + draw_data->TotalIdxCount += draw_lists->Data[n]->IdxBuffer.Size; + } +} + +// Push a clipping rectangle for both ImGui logic (hit-testing etc.) and low-level ImDrawList rendering. +// - When using this function it is sane to ensure that float are perfectly rounded to integer values, +// so that e.g. (int)(max.x-min.x) in user's render produce correct result. +// - If the code here changes, may need to update code of functions like NextColumn() and PushColumnClipRect(): +// some frequently called functions which to modify both channels and clipping simultaneously tend to use the +// more specialized SetWindowClipRectBeforeSetChannel() to avoid extraneous updates of underlying ImDrawCmds. +void ImGui::PushClipRect(const ImVec2& clip_rect_min, const ImVec2& clip_rect_max, bool intersect_with_current_clip_rect) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + window->DrawList->PushClipRect(clip_rect_min, clip_rect_max, intersect_with_current_clip_rect); + window->ClipRect = window->DrawList->_ClipRectStack.back(); +} + +void ImGui::PopClipRect() +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + window->DrawList->PopClipRect(); + window->ClipRect = window->DrawList->_ClipRectStack.back(); +} + +// This is normally called by Render(). You may want to call it directly if you want to avoid calling Render() but the gain will be very minimal. +void ImGui::EndFrame() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + IM_ASSERT(g.Initialized); + + // Don't process EndFrame() multiple times. + if (g.FrameCountEnded == g.FrameCount) + return; + IM_ASSERT(g.WithinFrameScope && "Forgot to call ImGui::NewFrame()?"); + + CallContextHooks(&g, ImGuiContextHookType_EndFramePre); + + ErrorCheckEndFrameSanityChecks(); + + // Notify OS when our Input Method Editor cursor has moved (e.g. CJK inputs using Microsoft IME) + if (g.IO.ImeSetInputScreenPosFn && (g.PlatformImeLastPos.x == FLT_MAX || ImLengthSqr(g.PlatformImeLastPos - g.PlatformImePos) > 0.0001f)) + { + g.IO.ImeSetInputScreenPosFn((int)g.PlatformImePos.x, (int)g.PlatformImePos.y); + g.PlatformImeLastPos = g.PlatformImePos; + } + + // Hide implicit/fallback "Debug" window if it hasn't been used + g.WithinFrameScopeWithImplicitWindow = false; + if (g.CurrentWindow && !g.CurrentWindow->WriteAccessed) + g.CurrentWindow->Active = false; + End(); + + // Update navigation: CTRL+Tab, wrap-around requests + NavEndFrame(); + + // Drag and Drop: Elapse payload (if delivered, or if source stops being submitted) + if (g.DragDropActive) + { + bool is_delivered = g.DragDropPayload.Delivery; + bool is_elapsed = (g.DragDropPayload.DataFrameCount + 1 < g.FrameCount) && ((g.DragDropSourceFlags & ImGuiDragDropFlags_SourceAutoExpirePayload) || !IsMouseDown(g.DragDropMouseButton)); + if (is_delivered || is_elapsed) + ClearDragDrop(); + } + + // Drag and Drop: Fallback for source tooltip. This is not ideal but better than nothing. + if (g.DragDropActive && g.DragDropSourceFrameCount < g.FrameCount && !(g.DragDropSourceFlags & ImGuiDragDropFlags_SourceNoPreviewTooltip)) + { + g.DragDropWithinSource = true; + SetTooltip("..."); + g.DragDropWithinSource = false; + } + + // End frame + g.WithinFrameScope = false; + g.FrameCountEnded = g.FrameCount; + + // Initiate moving window + handle left-click and right-click focus + UpdateMouseMovingWindowEndFrame(); + + // Sort the window list so that all child windows are after their parent + // We cannot do that on FocusWindow() because children may not exist yet + g.WindowsTempSortBuffer.resize(0); + g.WindowsTempSortBuffer.reserve(g.Windows.Size); + for (int i = 0; i != g.Windows.Size; i++) + { + ImGuiWindow* window = g.Windows[i]; + if (window->Active && (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow)) // if a child is active its parent will add it + continue; + AddWindowToSortBuffer(&g.WindowsTempSortBuffer, window); + } + + // This usually assert if there is a mismatch between the ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow / ParentWindow values and DC.ChildWindows[] in parents, aka we've done something wrong. + IM_ASSERT(g.Windows.Size == g.WindowsTempSortBuffer.Size); + g.Windows.swap(g.WindowsTempSortBuffer); + g.IO.MetricsActiveWindows = g.WindowsActiveCount; + + // Unlock font atlas + g.IO.Fonts->Locked = false; + + // Clear Input data for next frame + g.IO.MouseWheel = g.IO.MouseWheelH = 0.0f; + g.IO.InputQueueCharacters.resize(0); + g.IO.KeyModsPrev = g.IO.KeyMods; // doing it here is better than in NewFrame() as we'll tolerate backend writing to KeyMods. If we want to firmly disallow it we should detect it. + memset(g.IO.NavInputs, 0, sizeof(g.IO.NavInputs)); + + CallContextHooks(&g, ImGuiContextHookType_EndFramePost); +} + +// Prepare the data for rendering so you can call GetDrawData() +// (As with anything within the ImGui:: namspace this doesn't touch your GPU or graphics API at all: +// it is the role of the ImGui_ImplXXXX_RenderDrawData() function provided by the renderer backend) +void ImGui::Render() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + IM_ASSERT(g.Initialized); + + if (g.FrameCountEnded != g.FrameCount) + EndFrame(); + g.FrameCountRendered = g.FrameCount; + g.IO.MetricsRenderWindows = 0; + + CallContextHooks(&g, ImGuiContextHookType_RenderPre); + + // Add background ImDrawList (for each active viewport) + for (int n = 0; n != g.Viewports.Size; n++) + { + ImGuiViewportP* viewport = g.Viewports[n]; + viewport->DrawDataBuilder.Clear(); + if (viewport->DrawLists[0] != NULL) + AddDrawListToDrawData(&viewport->DrawDataBuilder.Layers[0], GetBackgroundDrawList(viewport)); + } + + // Add ImDrawList to render + ImGuiWindow* windows_to_render_top_most[2]; + windows_to_render_top_most[0] = (g.NavWindowingTarget && !(g.NavWindowingTarget->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoBringToFrontOnFocus)) ? g.NavWindowingTarget->RootWindow : NULL; + windows_to_render_top_most[1] = (g.NavWindowingTarget ? g.NavWindowingListWindow : NULL); + for (int n = 0; n != g.Windows.Size; n++) + { + ImGuiWindow* window = g.Windows[n]; + IM_MSVC_WARNING_SUPPRESS(6011); // Static Analysis false positive "warning C6011: Dereferencing NULL pointer 'window'" + if (IsWindowActiveAndVisible(window) && (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow) == 0 && window != windows_to_render_top_most[0] && window != windows_to_render_top_most[1]) + AddRootWindowToDrawData(window); + } + for (int n = 0; n < IM_ARRAYSIZE(windows_to_render_top_most); n++) + if (windows_to_render_top_most[n] && IsWindowActiveAndVisible(windows_to_render_top_most[n])) // NavWindowingTarget is always temporarily displayed as the top-most window + AddRootWindowToDrawData(windows_to_render_top_most[n]); + + // Setup ImDrawData structures for end-user + g.IO.MetricsRenderVertices = g.IO.MetricsRenderIndices = 0; + for (int n = 0; n < g.Viewports.Size; n++) + { + ImGuiViewportP* viewport = g.Viewports[n]; + viewport->DrawDataBuilder.FlattenIntoSingleLayer(); + + // Draw software mouse cursor if requested by io.MouseDrawCursor flag + if (g.IO.MouseDrawCursor) + RenderMouseCursor(GetForegroundDrawList(viewport), g.IO.MousePos, g.Style.MouseCursorScale, g.MouseCursor, IM_COL32_WHITE, IM_COL32_BLACK, IM_COL32(0, 0, 0, 48)); + + // Add foreground ImDrawList (for each active viewport) + if (viewport->DrawLists[1] != NULL) + AddDrawListToDrawData(&viewport->DrawDataBuilder.Layers[0], GetForegroundDrawList(viewport)); + + SetupViewportDrawData(viewport, &viewport->DrawDataBuilder.Layers[0]); + ImDrawData* draw_data = &viewport->DrawDataP; + g.IO.MetricsRenderVertices += draw_data->TotalVtxCount; + g.IO.MetricsRenderIndices += draw_data->TotalIdxCount; + } + + CallContextHooks(&g, ImGuiContextHookType_RenderPost); +} + +// Calculate text size. Text can be multi-line. Optionally ignore text after a ## marker. +// CalcTextSize("") should return ImVec2(0.0f, g.FontSize) +ImVec2 ImGui::CalcTextSize(const char* text, const char* text_end, bool hide_text_after_double_hash, float wrap_width) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + + const char* text_display_end; + if (hide_text_after_double_hash) + text_display_end = FindRenderedTextEnd(text, text_end); // Hide anything after a '##' string + else + text_display_end = text_end; + + ImFont* font = g.Font; + const float font_size = g.FontSize; + if (text == text_display_end) + return ImVec2(0.0f, font_size); + ImVec2 text_size = font->CalcTextSizeA(font_size, FLT_MAX, wrap_width, text, text_display_end, NULL); + + // Round + // FIXME: This has been here since Dec 2015 (7b0bf230) but down the line we want this out. + // FIXME: Investigate using ceilf or e.g. + // - https://git.musl-libc.org/cgit/musl/tree/src/math/ceilf.c + // - https://embarkstudios.github.io/rust-gpu/api/src/libm/math/ceilf.rs.html + text_size.x = IM_FLOOR(text_size.x + 0.99999f); + + return text_size; +} + +// Find window given position, search front-to-back +// FIXME: Note that we have an inconsequential lag here: OuterRectClipped is updated in Begin(), so windows moved programmatically +// with SetWindowPos() and not SetNextWindowPos() will have that rectangle lagging by a frame at the time FindHoveredWindow() is +// called, aka before the next Begin(). Moving window isn't affected. +static void FindHoveredWindow() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + + ImGuiWindow* hovered_window = NULL; + ImGuiWindow* hovered_window_ignoring_moving_window = NULL; + if (g.MovingWindow && !(g.MovingWindow->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoMouseInputs)) + hovered_window = g.MovingWindow; + + ImVec2 padding_regular = g.Style.TouchExtraPadding; + ImVec2 padding_for_resize = g.IO.ConfigWindowsResizeFromEdges ? g.WindowsHoverPadding : padding_regular; + for (int i = g.Windows.Size - 1; i >= 0; i--) + { + ImGuiWindow* window = g.Windows[i]; + IM_MSVC_WARNING_SUPPRESS(28182); // [Static Analyzer] Dereferencing NULL pointer. + if (!window->Active || window->Hidden) + continue; + if (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoMouseInputs) + continue; + + // Using the clipped AABB, a child window will typically be clipped by its parent (not always) + ImRect bb(window->OuterRectClipped); + if (window->Flags & (ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoResize | ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize)) + bb.Expand(padding_regular); + else + bb.Expand(padding_for_resize); + if (!bb.Contains(g.IO.MousePos)) + continue; + + // Support for one rectangular hole in any given window + // FIXME: Consider generalizing hit-testing override (with more generic data, callback, etc.) (#1512) + if (window->HitTestHoleSize.x != 0) + { + ImVec2 hole_pos(window->Pos.x + (float)window->HitTestHoleOffset.x, window->Pos.y + (float)window->HitTestHoleOffset.y); + ImVec2 hole_size((float)window->HitTestHoleSize.x, (float)window->HitTestHoleSize.y); + if (ImRect(hole_pos, hole_pos + hole_size).Contains(g.IO.MousePos)) + continue; + } + + if (hovered_window == NULL) + hovered_window = window; + IM_MSVC_WARNING_SUPPRESS(28182); // [Static Analyzer] Dereferencing NULL pointer. + if (hovered_window_ignoring_moving_window == NULL && (!g.MovingWindow || window->RootWindow != g.MovingWindow->RootWindow)) + hovered_window_ignoring_moving_window = window; + if (hovered_window && hovered_window_ignoring_moving_window) + break; + } + + g.HoveredWindow = hovered_window; + g.HoveredWindowUnderMovingWindow = hovered_window_ignoring_moving_window; +} + +// Test if mouse cursor is hovering given rectangle +// NB- Rectangle is clipped by our current clip setting +// NB- Expand the rectangle to be generous on imprecise inputs systems (g.Style.TouchExtraPadding) +bool ImGui::IsMouseHoveringRect(const ImVec2& r_min, const ImVec2& r_max, bool clip) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + + // Clip + ImRect rect_clipped(r_min, r_max); + if (clip) + rect_clipped.ClipWith(g.CurrentWindow->ClipRect); + + // Expand for touch input + const ImRect rect_for_touch(rect_clipped.Min - g.Style.TouchExtraPadding, rect_clipped.Max + g.Style.TouchExtraPadding); + if (!rect_for_touch.Contains(g.IO.MousePos)) + return false; + return true; +} + +int ImGui::GetKeyIndex(ImGuiKey imgui_key) +{ + IM_ASSERT(imgui_key >= 0 && imgui_key < ImGuiKey_COUNT); + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + return g.IO.KeyMap[imgui_key]; +} + +// Note that dear imgui doesn't know the semantic of each entry of io.KeysDown[]! +// Use your own indices/enums according to how your backend/engine stored them into io.KeysDown[]! +bool ImGui::IsKeyDown(int user_key_index) +{ + if (user_key_index < 0) + return false; + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + IM_ASSERT(user_key_index >= 0 && user_key_index < IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.IO.KeysDown)); + return g.IO.KeysDown[user_key_index]; +} + +// t0 = previous time (e.g.: g.Time - g.IO.DeltaTime) +// t1 = current time (e.g.: g.Time) +// An event is triggered at: +// t = 0.0f t = repeat_delay, t = repeat_delay + repeat_rate*N +int ImGui::CalcTypematicRepeatAmount(float t0, float t1, float repeat_delay, float repeat_rate) +{ + if (t1 == 0.0f) + return 1; + if (t0 >= t1) + return 0; + if (repeat_rate <= 0.0f) + return (t0 < repeat_delay) && (t1 >= repeat_delay); + const int count_t0 = (t0 < repeat_delay) ? -1 : (int)((t0 - repeat_delay) / repeat_rate); + const int count_t1 = (t1 < repeat_delay) ? -1 : (int)((t1 - repeat_delay) / repeat_rate); + const int count = count_t1 - count_t0; + return count; +} + +int ImGui::GetKeyPressedAmount(int key_index, float repeat_delay, float repeat_rate) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + if (key_index < 0) + return 0; + IM_ASSERT(key_index >= 0 && key_index < IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.IO.KeysDown)); + const float t = g.IO.KeysDownDuration[key_index]; + return CalcTypematicRepeatAmount(t - g.IO.DeltaTime, t, repeat_delay, repeat_rate); +} + +bool ImGui::IsKeyPressed(int user_key_index, bool repeat) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + if (user_key_index < 0) + return false; + IM_ASSERT(user_key_index >= 0 && user_key_index < IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.IO.KeysDown)); + const float t = g.IO.KeysDownDuration[user_key_index]; + if (t == 0.0f) + return true; + if (repeat && t > g.IO.KeyRepeatDelay) + return GetKeyPressedAmount(user_key_index, g.IO.KeyRepeatDelay, g.IO.KeyRepeatRate) > 0; + return false; +} + +bool ImGui::IsKeyReleased(int user_key_index) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + if (user_key_index < 0) return false; + IM_ASSERT(user_key_index >= 0 && user_key_index < IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.IO.KeysDown)); + return g.IO.KeysDownDurationPrev[user_key_index] >= 0.0f && !g.IO.KeysDown[user_key_index]; +} + +bool ImGui::IsMouseDown(ImGuiMouseButton button) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + IM_ASSERT(button >= 0 && button < IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.IO.MouseDown)); + return g.IO.MouseDown[button]; +} + +bool ImGui::IsMouseClicked(ImGuiMouseButton button, bool repeat) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + IM_ASSERT(button >= 0 && button < IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.IO.MouseDown)); + const float t = g.IO.MouseDownDuration[button]; + if (t == 0.0f) + return true; + + if (repeat && t > g.IO.KeyRepeatDelay) + { + // FIXME: 2019/05/03: Our old repeat code was wrong here and led to doubling the repeat rate, which made it an ok rate for repeat on mouse hold. + int amount = CalcTypematicRepeatAmount(t - g.IO.DeltaTime, t, g.IO.KeyRepeatDelay, g.IO.KeyRepeatRate * 0.50f); + if (amount > 0) + return true; + } + return false; +} + +bool ImGui::IsMouseReleased(ImGuiMouseButton button) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + IM_ASSERT(button >= 0 && button < IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.IO.MouseDown)); + return g.IO.MouseReleased[button]; +} + +bool ImGui::IsMouseDoubleClicked(ImGuiMouseButton button) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + IM_ASSERT(button >= 0 && button < IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.IO.MouseDown)); + return g.IO.MouseDoubleClicked[button]; +} + +// Return if a mouse click/drag went past the given threshold. Valid to call during the MouseReleased frame. +// [Internal] This doesn't test if the button is pressed +bool ImGui::IsMouseDragPastThreshold(ImGuiMouseButton button, float lock_threshold) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + IM_ASSERT(button >= 0 && button < IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.IO.MouseDown)); + if (lock_threshold < 0.0f) + lock_threshold = g.IO.MouseDragThreshold; + return g.IO.MouseDragMaxDistanceSqr[button] >= lock_threshold * lock_threshold; +} + +bool ImGui::IsMouseDragging(ImGuiMouseButton button, float lock_threshold) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + IM_ASSERT(button >= 0 && button < IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.IO.MouseDown)); + if (!g.IO.MouseDown[button]) + return false; + return IsMouseDragPastThreshold(button, lock_threshold); +} + +ImVec2 ImGui::GetMousePos() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + return g.IO.MousePos; +} + +// NB: prefer to call right after BeginPopup(). At the time Selectable/MenuItem is activated, the popup is already closed! +ImVec2 ImGui::GetMousePosOnOpeningCurrentPopup() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + if (g.BeginPopupStack.Size > 0) + return g.OpenPopupStack[g.BeginPopupStack.Size - 1].OpenMousePos; + return g.IO.MousePos; +} + +// We typically use ImVec2(-FLT_MAX,-FLT_MAX) to denote an invalid mouse position. +bool ImGui::IsMousePosValid(const ImVec2* mouse_pos) +{ + // The assert is only to silence a false-positive in XCode Static Analysis. + // Because GImGui is not dereferenced in every code path, the static analyzer assume that it may be NULL (which it doesn't for other functions). + IM_ASSERT(GImGui != NULL); + const float MOUSE_INVALID = -256000.0f; + ImVec2 p = mouse_pos ? *mouse_pos : GImGui->IO.MousePos; + return p.x >= MOUSE_INVALID && p.y >= MOUSE_INVALID; +} + +bool ImGui::IsAnyMouseDown() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + for (int n = 0; n < IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.IO.MouseDown); n++) + if (g.IO.MouseDown[n]) + return true; + return false; +} + +// Return the delta from the initial clicking position while the mouse button is clicked or was just released. +// This is locked and return 0.0f until the mouse moves past a distance threshold at least once. +// NB: This is only valid if IsMousePosValid(). backends in theory should always keep mouse position valid when dragging even outside the client window. +ImVec2 ImGui::GetMouseDragDelta(ImGuiMouseButton button, float lock_threshold) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + IM_ASSERT(button >= 0 && button < IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.IO.MouseDown)); + if (lock_threshold < 0.0f) + lock_threshold = g.IO.MouseDragThreshold; + if (g.IO.MouseDown[button] || g.IO.MouseReleased[button]) + if (g.IO.MouseDragMaxDistanceSqr[button] >= lock_threshold * lock_threshold) + if (IsMousePosValid(&g.IO.MousePos) && IsMousePosValid(&g.IO.MouseClickedPos[button])) + return g.IO.MousePos - g.IO.MouseClickedPos[button]; + return ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f); +} + +void ImGui::ResetMouseDragDelta(ImGuiMouseButton button) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + IM_ASSERT(button >= 0 && button < IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.IO.MouseDown)); + // NB: We don't need to reset g.IO.MouseDragMaxDistanceSqr + g.IO.MouseClickedPos[button] = g.IO.MousePos; +} + +ImGuiMouseCursor ImGui::GetMouseCursor() +{ + return GImGui->MouseCursor; +} + +void ImGui::SetMouseCursor(ImGuiMouseCursor cursor_type) +{ + GImGui->MouseCursor = cursor_type; +} + +void ImGui::CaptureKeyboardFromApp(bool capture) +{ + GImGui->WantCaptureKeyboardNextFrame = capture ? 1 : 0; +} + +void ImGui::CaptureMouseFromApp(bool capture) +{ + GImGui->WantCaptureMouseNextFrame = capture ? 1 : 0; +} + +bool ImGui::IsItemActive() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + if (g.ActiveId) + return g.ActiveId == g.LastItemData.ID; + return false; +} + +bool ImGui::IsItemActivated() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + if (g.ActiveId) + if (g.ActiveId == g.LastItemData.ID && g.ActiveIdPreviousFrame != g.LastItemData.ID) + return true; + return false; +} + +bool ImGui::IsItemDeactivated() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + if (g.LastItemData.StatusFlags & ImGuiItemStatusFlags_HasDeactivated) + return (g.LastItemData.StatusFlags & ImGuiItemStatusFlags_Deactivated) != 0; + return (g.ActiveIdPreviousFrame == g.LastItemData.ID && g.ActiveIdPreviousFrame != 0 && g.ActiveId != g.LastItemData.ID); +} + +bool ImGui::IsItemDeactivatedAfterEdit() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + return IsItemDeactivated() && (g.ActiveIdPreviousFrameHasBeenEditedBefore || (g.ActiveId == 0 && g.ActiveIdHasBeenEditedBefore)); +} + +// == GetItemID() == GetFocusID() +bool ImGui::IsItemFocused() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + if (g.NavId != g.LastItemData.ID || g.NavId == 0) + return false; + return true; +} + +// Important: this can be useful but it is NOT equivalent to the behavior of e.g.Button()! +// Most widgets have specific reactions based on mouse-up/down state, mouse position etc. +bool ImGui::IsItemClicked(ImGuiMouseButton mouse_button) +{ + return IsMouseClicked(mouse_button) && IsItemHovered(ImGuiHoveredFlags_None); +} + +bool ImGui::IsItemToggledOpen() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + return (g.LastItemData.StatusFlags & ImGuiItemStatusFlags_ToggledOpen) ? true : false; +} + +bool ImGui::IsItemToggledSelection() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + return (g.LastItemData.StatusFlags & ImGuiItemStatusFlags_ToggledSelection) ? true : false; +} + +bool ImGui::IsAnyItemHovered() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + return g.HoveredId != 0 || g.HoveredIdPreviousFrame != 0; +} + +bool ImGui::IsAnyItemActive() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + return g.ActiveId != 0; +} + +bool ImGui::IsAnyItemFocused() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + return g.NavId != 0 && !g.NavDisableHighlight; +} + +bool ImGui::IsItemVisible() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + return g.CurrentWindow->ClipRect.Overlaps(g.LastItemData.Rect); +} + +bool ImGui::IsItemEdited() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + return (g.LastItemData.StatusFlags & ImGuiItemStatusFlags_Edited) != 0; +} + +// Allow last item to be overlapped by a subsequent item. Both may be activated during the same frame before the later one takes priority. +// FIXME: Although this is exposed, its interaction and ideal idiom with using ImGuiButtonFlags_AllowItemOverlap flag are extremely confusing, need rework. +void ImGui::SetItemAllowOverlap() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiID id = g.LastItemData.ID; + if (g.HoveredId == id) + g.HoveredIdAllowOverlap = true; + if (g.ActiveId == id) + g.ActiveIdAllowOverlap = true; +} + +void ImGui::SetItemUsingMouseWheel() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiID id = g.LastItemData.ID; + if (g.HoveredId == id) + g.HoveredIdUsingMouseWheel = true; + if (g.ActiveId == id) + g.ActiveIdUsingMouseWheel = true; +} + +void ImGui::SetActiveIdUsingNavAndKeys() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + IM_ASSERT(g.ActiveId != 0); + g.ActiveIdUsingNavDirMask = ~(ImU32)0; + g.ActiveIdUsingNavInputMask = ~(ImU32)0; + g.ActiveIdUsingKeyInputMask = ~(ImU64)0; + NavMoveRequestCancel(); +} + +ImVec2 ImGui::GetItemRectMin() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + return g.LastItemData.Rect.Min; +} + +ImVec2 ImGui::GetItemRectMax() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + return g.LastItemData.Rect.Max; +} + +ImVec2 ImGui::GetItemRectSize() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + return g.LastItemData.Rect.GetSize(); +} + +bool ImGui::BeginChildEx(const char* name, ImGuiID id, const ImVec2& size_arg, bool border, ImGuiWindowFlags flags) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* parent_window = g.CurrentWindow; + + flags |= ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoResize | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoSavedSettings | ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow; + flags |= (parent_window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoMove); // Inherit the NoMove flag + + // Size + const ImVec2 content_avail = GetContentRegionAvail(); + ImVec2 size = ImFloor(size_arg); + const int auto_fit_axises = ((size.x == 0.0f) ? (1 << ImGuiAxis_X) : 0x00) | ((size.y == 0.0f) ? (1 << ImGuiAxis_Y) : 0x00); + if (size.x <= 0.0f) + size.x = ImMax(content_avail.x + size.x, 4.0f); // Arbitrary minimum child size (0.0f causing too much issues) + if (size.y <= 0.0f) + size.y = ImMax(content_avail.y + size.y, 4.0f); + SetNextWindowSize(size); + + // Build up name. If you need to append to a same child from multiple location in the ID stack, use BeginChild(ImGuiID id) with a stable value. + if (name) + ImFormatString(g.TempBuffer, IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.TempBuffer), "%s/%s_%08X", parent_window->Name, name, id); + else + ImFormatString(g.TempBuffer, IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.TempBuffer), "%s/%08X", parent_window->Name, id); + + const float backup_border_size = g.Style.ChildBorderSize; + if (!border) + g.Style.ChildBorderSize = 0.0f; + bool ret = Begin(g.TempBuffer, NULL, flags); + g.Style.ChildBorderSize = backup_border_size; + + ImGuiWindow* child_window = g.CurrentWindow; + child_window->ChildId = id; + child_window->AutoFitChildAxises = (ImS8)auto_fit_axises; + + // Set the cursor to handle case where the user called SetNextWindowPos()+BeginChild() manually. + // While this is not really documented/defined, it seems that the expected thing to do. + if (child_window->BeginCount == 1) + parent_window->DC.CursorPos = child_window->Pos; + + // Process navigation-in immediately so NavInit can run on first frame + if (g.NavActivateId == id && !(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NavFlattened) && (child_window->DC.NavLayersActiveMask != 0 || child_window->DC.NavHasScroll)) + { + FocusWindow(child_window); + NavInitWindow(child_window, false); + SetActiveID(id + 1, child_window); // Steal ActiveId with another arbitrary id so that key-press won't activate child item + g.ActiveIdSource = ImGuiInputSource_Nav; + } + return ret; +} + +bool ImGui::BeginChild(const char* str_id, const ImVec2& size_arg, bool border, ImGuiWindowFlags extra_flags) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + return BeginChildEx(str_id, window->GetID(str_id), size_arg, border, extra_flags); +} + +bool ImGui::BeginChild(ImGuiID id, const ImVec2& size_arg, bool border, ImGuiWindowFlags extra_flags) +{ + IM_ASSERT(id != 0); + return BeginChildEx(NULL, id, size_arg, border, extra_flags); +} + +void ImGui::EndChild() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + + IM_ASSERT(g.WithinEndChild == false); + IM_ASSERT(window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow); // Mismatched BeginChild()/EndChild() calls + + g.WithinEndChild = true; + if (window->BeginCount > 1) + { + End(); + } + else + { + ImVec2 sz = window->Size; + if (window->AutoFitChildAxises & (1 << ImGuiAxis_X)) // Arbitrary minimum zero-ish child size of 4.0f causes less trouble than a 0.0f + sz.x = ImMax(4.0f, sz.x); + if (window->AutoFitChildAxises & (1 << ImGuiAxis_Y)) + sz.y = ImMax(4.0f, sz.y); + End(); + + ImGuiWindow* parent_window = g.CurrentWindow; + ImRect bb(parent_window->DC.CursorPos, parent_window->DC.CursorPos + sz); + ItemSize(sz); + if ((window->DC.NavLayersActiveMask != 0 || window->DC.NavHasScroll) && !(window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NavFlattened)) + { + ItemAdd(bb, window->ChildId); + RenderNavHighlight(bb, window->ChildId); + + // When browsing a window that has no activable items (scroll only) we keep a highlight on the child + if (window->DC.NavLayersActiveMask == 0 && window == g.NavWindow) + RenderNavHighlight(ImRect(bb.Min - ImVec2(2, 2), bb.Max + ImVec2(2, 2)), g.NavId, ImGuiNavHighlightFlags_TypeThin); + } + else + { + // Not navigable into + ItemAdd(bb, 0); + } + if (g.HoveredWindow == window) + g.LastItemData.StatusFlags |= ImGuiItemStatusFlags_HoveredWindow; + } + g.WithinEndChild = false; + g.LogLinePosY = -FLT_MAX; // To enforce a carriage return +} + +// Helper to create a child window / scrolling region that looks like a normal widget frame. +bool ImGui::BeginChildFrame(ImGuiID id, const ImVec2& size, ImGuiWindowFlags extra_flags) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style; + PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_ChildBg, style.Colors[ImGuiCol_FrameBg]); + PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_ChildRounding, style.FrameRounding); + PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_ChildBorderSize, style.FrameBorderSize); + PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_WindowPadding, style.FramePadding); + bool ret = BeginChild(id, size, true, ImGuiWindowFlags_NoMove | ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysUseWindowPadding | extra_flags); + PopStyleVar(3); + PopStyleColor(); + return ret; +} + +void ImGui::EndChildFrame() +{ + EndChild(); +} + +static void SetWindowConditionAllowFlags(ImGuiWindow* window, ImGuiCond flags, bool enabled) +{ + window->SetWindowPosAllowFlags = enabled ? (window->SetWindowPosAllowFlags | flags) : (window->SetWindowPosAllowFlags & ~flags); + window->SetWindowSizeAllowFlags = enabled ? (window->SetWindowSizeAllowFlags | flags) : (window->SetWindowSizeAllowFlags & ~flags); + window->SetWindowCollapsedAllowFlags = enabled ? (window->SetWindowCollapsedAllowFlags | flags) : (window->SetWindowCollapsedAllowFlags & ~flags); +} + +ImGuiWindow* ImGui::FindWindowByID(ImGuiID id) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + return (ImGuiWindow*)g.WindowsById.GetVoidPtr(id); +} + +ImGuiWindow* ImGui::FindWindowByName(const char* name) +{ + ImGuiID id = ImHashStr(name); + return FindWindowByID(id); +} + +static void ApplyWindowSettings(ImGuiWindow* window, ImGuiWindowSettings* settings) +{ + window->Pos = ImFloor(ImVec2(settings->Pos.x, settings->Pos.y)); + if (settings->Size.x > 0 && settings->Size.y > 0) + window->Size = window->SizeFull = ImFloor(ImVec2(settings->Size.x, settings->Size.y)); + window->Collapsed = settings->Collapsed; +} + +static ImGuiWindow* CreateNewWindow(const char* name, ImGuiWindowFlags flags) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + //IMGUI_DEBUG_LOG("CreateNewWindow '%s', flags = 0x%08X\n", name, flags); + + // Create window the first time + ImGuiWindow* window = IM_NEW(ImGuiWindow)(&g, name); + window->Flags = flags; + g.WindowsById.SetVoidPtr(window->ID, window); + + // Default/arbitrary window position. Use SetNextWindowPos() with the appropriate condition flag to change the initial position of a window. + const ImGuiViewport* main_viewport = ImGui::GetMainViewport(); + window->Pos = main_viewport->Pos + ImVec2(60, 60); + + // User can disable loading and saving of settings. Tooltip and child windows also don't store settings. + if (!(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoSavedSettings)) + if (ImGuiWindowSettings* settings = ImGui::FindWindowSettings(window->ID)) + { + // Retrieve settings from .ini file + window->SettingsOffset = g.SettingsWindows.offset_from_ptr(settings); + SetWindowConditionAllowFlags(window, ImGuiCond_FirstUseEver, false); + ApplyWindowSettings(window, settings); + } + window->DC.CursorStartPos = window->DC.CursorMaxPos = window->Pos; // So first call to CalcContentSize() doesn't return crazy values + + if ((flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize) != 0) + { + window->AutoFitFramesX = window->AutoFitFramesY = 2; + window->AutoFitOnlyGrows = false; + } + else + { + if (window->Size.x <= 0.0f) + window->AutoFitFramesX = 2; + if (window->Size.y <= 0.0f) + window->AutoFitFramesY = 2; + window->AutoFitOnlyGrows = (window->AutoFitFramesX > 0) || (window->AutoFitFramesY > 0); + } + + if (!(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow)) + { + g.WindowsFocusOrder.push_back(window); + window->FocusOrder = (short)(g.WindowsFocusOrder.Size - 1); + } + + if (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoBringToFrontOnFocus) + g.Windows.push_front(window); // Quite slow but rare and only once + else + g.Windows.push_back(window); + return window; +} + +static ImVec2 CalcWindowSizeAfterConstraint(ImGuiWindow* window, const ImVec2& size_desired) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImVec2 new_size = size_desired; + if (g.NextWindowData.Flags & ImGuiNextWindowDataFlags_HasSizeConstraint) + { + // Using -1,-1 on either X/Y axis to preserve the current size. + ImRect cr = g.NextWindowData.SizeConstraintRect; + new_size.x = (cr.Min.x >= 0 && cr.Max.x >= 0) ? ImClamp(new_size.x, cr.Min.x, cr.Max.x) : window->SizeFull.x; + new_size.y = (cr.Min.y >= 0 && cr.Max.y >= 0) ? ImClamp(new_size.y, cr.Min.y, cr.Max.y) : window->SizeFull.y; + if (g.NextWindowData.SizeCallback) + { + ImGuiSizeCallbackData data; + data.UserData = g.NextWindowData.SizeCallbackUserData; + data.Pos = window->Pos; + data.CurrentSize = window->SizeFull; + data.DesiredSize = new_size; + g.NextWindowData.SizeCallback(&data); + new_size = data.DesiredSize; + } + new_size.x = IM_FLOOR(new_size.x); + new_size.y = IM_FLOOR(new_size.y); + } + + // Minimum size + if (!(window->Flags & (ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow | ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize))) + { + ImGuiWindow* window_for_height = window; + const float decoration_up_height = window_for_height->TitleBarHeight() + window_for_height->MenuBarHeight(); + new_size = ImMax(new_size, g.Style.WindowMinSize); + new_size.y = ImMax(new_size.y, decoration_up_height + ImMax(0.0f, g.Style.WindowRounding - 1.0f)); // Reduce artifacts with very small windows + } + return new_size; +} + +static void CalcWindowContentSizes(ImGuiWindow* window, ImVec2* content_size_current, ImVec2* content_size_ideal) +{ + bool preserve_old_content_sizes = false; + if (window->Collapsed && window->AutoFitFramesX <= 0 && window->AutoFitFramesY <= 0) + preserve_old_content_sizes = true; + else if (window->Hidden && window->HiddenFramesCannotSkipItems == 0 && window->HiddenFramesCanSkipItems > 0) + preserve_old_content_sizes = true; + if (preserve_old_content_sizes) + { + *content_size_current = window->ContentSize; + *content_size_ideal = window->ContentSizeIdeal; + return; + } + + content_size_current->x = (window->ContentSizeExplicit.x != 0.0f) ? window->ContentSizeExplicit.x : IM_FLOOR(window->DC.CursorMaxPos.x - window->DC.CursorStartPos.x); + content_size_current->y = (window->ContentSizeExplicit.y != 0.0f) ? window->ContentSizeExplicit.y : IM_FLOOR(window->DC.CursorMaxPos.y - window->DC.CursorStartPos.y); + content_size_ideal->x = (window->ContentSizeExplicit.x != 0.0f) ? window->ContentSizeExplicit.x : IM_FLOOR(ImMax(window->DC.CursorMaxPos.x, window->DC.IdealMaxPos.x) - window->DC.CursorStartPos.x); + content_size_ideal->y = (window->ContentSizeExplicit.y != 0.0f) ? window->ContentSizeExplicit.y : IM_FLOOR(ImMax(window->DC.CursorMaxPos.y, window->DC.IdealMaxPos.y) - window->DC.CursorStartPos.y); +} + +static ImVec2 CalcWindowAutoFitSize(ImGuiWindow* window, const ImVec2& size_contents) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style; + const float decoration_up_height = window->TitleBarHeight() + window->MenuBarHeight(); + ImVec2 size_pad = window->WindowPadding * 2.0f; + ImVec2 size_desired = size_contents + size_pad + ImVec2(0.0f, decoration_up_height); + if (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Tooltip) + { + // Tooltip always resize + return size_desired; + } + else + { + // Maximum window size is determined by the viewport size or monitor size + const bool is_popup = (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup) != 0; + const bool is_menu = (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildMenu) != 0; + ImVec2 size_min = style.WindowMinSize; + if (is_popup || is_menu) // Popups and menus bypass style.WindowMinSize by default, but we give then a non-zero minimum size to facilitate understanding problematic cases (e.g. empty popups) + size_min = ImMin(size_min, ImVec2(4.0f, 4.0f)); + + // FIXME-VIEWPORT-WORKAREA: May want to use GetWorkSize() instead of Size depending on the type of windows? + ImVec2 avail_size = ImGui::GetMainViewport()->Size; + ImVec2 size_auto_fit = ImClamp(size_desired, size_min, ImMax(size_min, avail_size - style.DisplaySafeAreaPadding * 2.0f)); + + // When the window cannot fit all contents (either because of constraints, either because screen is too small), + // we are growing the size on the other axis to compensate for expected scrollbar. FIXME: Might turn bigger than ViewportSize-WindowPadding. + ImVec2 size_auto_fit_after_constraint = CalcWindowSizeAfterConstraint(window, size_auto_fit); + bool will_have_scrollbar_x = (size_auto_fit_after_constraint.x - size_pad.x - 0.0f < size_contents.x && !(window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoScrollbar) && (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_HorizontalScrollbar)) || (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysHorizontalScrollbar); + bool will_have_scrollbar_y = (size_auto_fit_after_constraint.y - size_pad.y - decoration_up_height < size_contents.y && !(window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoScrollbar)) || (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysVerticalScrollbar); + if (will_have_scrollbar_x) + size_auto_fit.y += style.ScrollbarSize; + if (will_have_scrollbar_y) + size_auto_fit.x += style.ScrollbarSize; + return size_auto_fit; + } +} + +ImVec2 ImGui::CalcWindowNextAutoFitSize(ImGuiWindow* window) +{ + ImVec2 size_contents_current; + ImVec2 size_contents_ideal; + CalcWindowContentSizes(window, &size_contents_current, &size_contents_ideal); + ImVec2 size_auto_fit = CalcWindowAutoFitSize(window, size_contents_ideal); + ImVec2 size_final = CalcWindowSizeAfterConstraint(window, size_auto_fit); + return size_final; +} + +static ImGuiCol GetWindowBgColorIdxFromFlags(ImGuiWindowFlags flags) +{ + if (flags & (ImGuiWindowFlags_Tooltip | ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup)) + return ImGuiCol_PopupBg; + if (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow) + return ImGuiCol_ChildBg; + return ImGuiCol_WindowBg; +} + +static void CalcResizePosSizeFromAnyCorner(ImGuiWindow* window, const ImVec2& corner_target, const ImVec2& corner_norm, ImVec2* out_pos, ImVec2* out_size) +{ + ImVec2 pos_min = ImLerp(corner_target, window->Pos, corner_norm); // Expected window upper-left + ImVec2 pos_max = ImLerp(window->Pos + window->Size, corner_target, corner_norm); // Expected window lower-right + ImVec2 size_expected = pos_max - pos_min; + ImVec2 size_constrained = CalcWindowSizeAfterConstraint(window, size_expected); + *out_pos = pos_min; + if (corner_norm.x == 0.0f) + out_pos->x -= (size_constrained.x - size_expected.x); + if (corner_norm.y == 0.0f) + out_pos->y -= (size_constrained.y - size_expected.y); + *out_size = size_constrained; +} + +// Data for resizing from corner +struct ImGuiResizeGripDef +{ + ImVec2 CornerPosN; + ImVec2 InnerDir; + int AngleMin12, AngleMax12; +}; +static const ImGuiResizeGripDef resize_grip_def[4] = +{ + { ImVec2(1, 1), ImVec2(-1, -1), 0, 3 }, // Lower-right + { ImVec2(0, 1), ImVec2(+1, -1), 3, 6 }, // Lower-left + { ImVec2(0, 0), ImVec2(+1, +1), 6, 9 }, // Upper-left (Unused) + { ImVec2(1, 0), ImVec2(-1, +1), 9, 12 } // Upper-right (Unused) +}; + +// Data for resizing from borders +struct ImGuiResizeBorderDef +{ + ImVec2 InnerDir; + ImVec2 SegmentN1, SegmentN2; + float OuterAngle; +}; +static const ImGuiResizeBorderDef resize_border_def[4] = +{ + { ImVec2(+1, 0), ImVec2(0, 1), ImVec2(0, 0), IM_PI * 1.00f }, // Left + { ImVec2(-1, 0), ImVec2(1, 0), ImVec2(1, 1), IM_PI * 0.00f }, // Right + { ImVec2(0, +1), ImVec2(0, 0), ImVec2(1, 0), IM_PI * 1.50f }, // Up + { ImVec2(0, -1), ImVec2(1, 1), ImVec2(0, 1), IM_PI * 0.50f } // Down +}; + +static ImRect GetResizeBorderRect(ImGuiWindow* window, int border_n, float perp_padding, float thickness) +{ + ImRect rect = window->Rect(); + if (thickness == 0.0f) + rect.Max -= ImVec2(1, 1); + if (border_n == ImGuiDir_Left) { return ImRect(rect.Min.x - thickness, rect.Min.y + perp_padding, rect.Min.x + thickness, rect.Max.y - perp_padding); } + if (border_n == ImGuiDir_Right) { return ImRect(rect.Max.x - thickness, rect.Min.y + perp_padding, rect.Max.x + thickness, rect.Max.y - perp_padding); } + if (border_n == ImGuiDir_Up) { return ImRect(rect.Min.x + perp_padding, rect.Min.y - thickness, rect.Max.x - perp_padding, rect.Min.y + thickness); } + if (border_n == ImGuiDir_Down) { return ImRect(rect.Min.x + perp_padding, rect.Max.y - thickness, rect.Max.x - perp_padding, rect.Max.y + thickness); } + IM_ASSERT(0); + return ImRect(); +} + +// 0..3: corners (Lower-right, Lower-left, Unused, Unused) +ImGuiID ImGui::GetWindowResizeCornerID(ImGuiWindow* window, int n) +{ + IM_ASSERT(n >= 0 && n < 4); + ImGuiID id = window->ID; + id = ImHashStr("#RESIZE", 0, id); + id = ImHashData(&n, sizeof(int), id); + return id; +} + +// Borders (Left, Right, Up, Down) +ImGuiID ImGui::GetWindowResizeBorderID(ImGuiWindow* window, ImGuiDir dir) +{ + IM_ASSERT(dir >= 0 && dir < 4); + int n = (int)dir + 4; + ImGuiID id = window->ID; + id = ImHashStr("#RESIZE", 0, id); + id = ImHashData(&n, sizeof(int), id); + return id; +} + +// Handle resize for: Resize Grips, Borders, Gamepad +// Return true when using auto-fit (double click on resize grip) +static bool ImGui::UpdateWindowManualResize(ImGuiWindow* window, const ImVec2& size_auto_fit, int* border_held, int resize_grip_count, ImU32 resize_grip_col[4], const ImRect& visibility_rect) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindowFlags flags = window->Flags; + + if ((flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoResize) || (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize) || window->AutoFitFramesX > 0 || window->AutoFitFramesY > 0) + return false; + if (window->WasActive == false) // Early out to avoid running this code for e.g. an hidden implicit/fallback Debug window. + return false; + + bool ret_auto_fit = false; + const int resize_border_count = g.IO.ConfigWindowsResizeFromEdges ? 4 : 0; + const float grip_draw_size = IM_FLOOR(ImMax(g.FontSize * 1.35f, window->WindowRounding + 1.0f + g.FontSize * 0.2f)); + const float grip_hover_inner_size = IM_FLOOR(grip_draw_size * 0.75f); + const float grip_hover_outer_size = g.IO.ConfigWindowsResizeFromEdges ? WINDOWS_HOVER_PADDING : 0.0f; + + ImVec2 pos_target(FLT_MAX, FLT_MAX); + ImVec2 size_target(FLT_MAX, FLT_MAX); + + // Resize grips and borders are on layer 1 + window->DC.NavLayerCurrent = ImGuiNavLayer_Menu; + + // Manual resize grips + PushID("#RESIZE"); + for (int resize_grip_n = 0; resize_grip_n < resize_grip_count; resize_grip_n++) + { + const ImGuiResizeGripDef& def = resize_grip_def[resize_grip_n]; + const ImVec2 corner = ImLerp(window->Pos, window->Pos + window->Size, def.CornerPosN); + + // Using the FlattenChilds button flag we make the resize button accessible even if we are hovering over a child window + bool hovered, held; + ImRect resize_rect(corner - def.InnerDir * grip_hover_outer_size, corner + def.InnerDir * grip_hover_inner_size); + if (resize_rect.Min.x > resize_rect.Max.x) ImSwap(resize_rect.Min.x, resize_rect.Max.x); + if (resize_rect.Min.y > resize_rect.Max.y) ImSwap(resize_rect.Min.y, resize_rect.Max.y); + ImGuiID resize_grip_id = window->GetID(resize_grip_n); // == GetWindowResizeCornerID() + ButtonBehavior(resize_rect, resize_grip_id, &hovered, &held, ImGuiButtonFlags_FlattenChildren | ImGuiButtonFlags_NoNavFocus); + //GetForegroundDrawList(window)->AddRect(resize_rect.Min, resize_rect.Max, IM_COL32(255, 255, 0, 255)); + if (hovered || held) + g.MouseCursor = (resize_grip_n & 1) ? ImGuiMouseCursor_ResizeNESW : ImGuiMouseCursor_ResizeNWSE; + + if (held && g.IO.MouseDoubleClicked[0] && resize_grip_n == 0) + { + // Manual auto-fit when double-clicking + size_target = CalcWindowSizeAfterConstraint(window, size_auto_fit); + ret_auto_fit = true; + ClearActiveID(); + } + else if (held) + { + // Resize from any of the four corners + // We don't use an incremental MouseDelta but rather compute an absolute target size based on mouse position + ImVec2 clamp_min = ImVec2(def.CornerPosN.x == 1.0f ? visibility_rect.Min.x : -FLT_MAX, def.CornerPosN.y == 1.0f ? visibility_rect.Min.y : -FLT_MAX); + ImVec2 clamp_max = ImVec2(def.CornerPosN.x == 0.0f ? visibility_rect.Max.x : +FLT_MAX, def.CornerPosN.y == 0.0f ? visibility_rect.Max.y : +FLT_MAX); + ImVec2 corner_target = g.IO.MousePos - g.ActiveIdClickOffset + ImLerp(def.InnerDir * grip_hover_outer_size, def.InnerDir * -grip_hover_inner_size, def.CornerPosN); // Corner of the window corresponding to our corner grip + corner_target = ImClamp(corner_target, clamp_min, clamp_max); + CalcResizePosSizeFromAnyCorner(window, corner_target, def.CornerPosN, &pos_target, &size_target); + } + + // Only lower-left grip is visible before hovering/activating + if (resize_grip_n == 0 || held || hovered) + resize_grip_col[resize_grip_n] = GetColorU32(held ? ImGuiCol_ResizeGripActive : hovered ? ImGuiCol_ResizeGripHovered : ImGuiCol_ResizeGrip); + } + for (int border_n = 0; border_n < resize_border_count; border_n++) + { + const ImGuiResizeBorderDef& def = resize_border_def[border_n]; + const ImGuiAxis axis = (border_n == ImGuiDir_Left || border_n == ImGuiDir_Right) ? ImGuiAxis_X : ImGuiAxis_Y; + + bool hovered, held; + ImRect border_rect = GetResizeBorderRect(window, border_n, grip_hover_inner_size, WINDOWS_HOVER_PADDING); + ImGuiID border_id = window->GetID(border_n + 4); // == GetWindowResizeBorderID() + ButtonBehavior(border_rect, border_id, &hovered, &held, ImGuiButtonFlags_FlattenChildren); + //GetForegroundDrawLists(window)->AddRect(border_rect.Min, border_rect.Max, IM_COL32(255, 255, 0, 255)); + if ((hovered && g.HoveredIdTimer > WINDOWS_RESIZE_FROM_EDGES_FEEDBACK_TIMER) || held) + { + g.MouseCursor = (axis == ImGuiAxis_X) ? ImGuiMouseCursor_ResizeEW : ImGuiMouseCursor_ResizeNS; + if (held) + *border_held = border_n; + } + if (held) + { + ImVec2 clamp_min(border_n == ImGuiDir_Right ? visibility_rect.Min.x : -FLT_MAX, border_n == ImGuiDir_Down ? visibility_rect.Min.y : -FLT_MAX); + ImVec2 clamp_max(border_n == ImGuiDir_Left ? visibility_rect.Max.x : +FLT_MAX, border_n == ImGuiDir_Up ? visibility_rect.Max.y : +FLT_MAX); + ImVec2 border_target = window->Pos; + border_target[axis] = g.IO.MousePos[axis] - g.ActiveIdClickOffset[axis] + WINDOWS_HOVER_PADDING; + border_target = ImClamp(border_target, clamp_min, clamp_max); + CalcResizePosSizeFromAnyCorner(window, border_target, ImMin(def.SegmentN1, def.SegmentN2), &pos_target, &size_target); + } + } + PopID(); + + // Restore nav layer + window->DC.NavLayerCurrent = ImGuiNavLayer_Main; + + // Navigation resize (keyboard/gamepad) + if (g.NavWindowingTarget && g.NavWindowingTarget->RootWindow == window) + { + ImVec2 nav_resize_delta; + if (g.NavInputSource == ImGuiInputSource_Keyboard && g.IO.KeyShift) + nav_resize_delta = GetNavInputAmount2d(ImGuiNavDirSourceFlags_Keyboard, ImGuiInputReadMode_Down); + if (g.NavInputSource == ImGuiInputSource_Gamepad) + nav_resize_delta = GetNavInputAmount2d(ImGuiNavDirSourceFlags_PadDPad, ImGuiInputReadMode_Down); + if (nav_resize_delta.x != 0.0f || nav_resize_delta.y != 0.0f) + { + const float NAV_RESIZE_SPEED = 600.0f; + nav_resize_delta *= ImFloor(NAV_RESIZE_SPEED * g.IO.DeltaTime * ImMin(g.IO.DisplayFramebufferScale.x, g.IO.DisplayFramebufferScale.y)); + nav_resize_delta = ImMax(nav_resize_delta, visibility_rect.Min - window->Pos - window->Size); + g.NavWindowingToggleLayer = false; + g.NavDisableMouseHover = true; + resize_grip_col[0] = GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_ResizeGripActive); + // FIXME-NAV: Should store and accumulate into a separate size buffer to handle sizing constraints properly, right now a constraint will make us stuck. + size_target = CalcWindowSizeAfterConstraint(window, window->SizeFull + nav_resize_delta); + } + } + + // Apply back modified position/size to window + if (size_target.x != FLT_MAX) + { + window->SizeFull = size_target; + MarkIniSettingsDirty(window); + } + if (pos_target.x != FLT_MAX) + { + window->Pos = ImFloor(pos_target); + MarkIniSettingsDirty(window); + } + + window->Size = window->SizeFull; + return ret_auto_fit; +} + +static inline void ClampWindowRect(ImGuiWindow* window, const ImRect& visibility_rect) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImVec2 size_for_clamping = window->Size; + if (g.IO.ConfigWindowsMoveFromTitleBarOnly && !(window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar)) + size_for_clamping.y = window->TitleBarHeight(); + window->Pos = ImClamp(window->Pos, visibility_rect.Min - size_for_clamping, visibility_rect.Max); +} + +static void ImGui::RenderWindowOuterBorders(ImGuiWindow* window) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + float rounding = window->WindowRounding; + float border_size = window->WindowBorderSize; + if (border_size > 0.0f && !(window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoBackground)) + window->DrawList->AddRect(window->Pos, window->Pos + window->Size, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Border), rounding, 0, border_size); + + int border_held = window->ResizeBorderHeld; + if (border_held != -1) + { + const ImGuiResizeBorderDef& def = resize_border_def[border_held]; + ImRect border_r = GetResizeBorderRect(window, border_held, rounding, 0.0f); + window->DrawList->PathArcTo(ImLerp(border_r.Min, border_r.Max, def.SegmentN1) + ImVec2(0.5f, 0.5f) + def.InnerDir * rounding, rounding, def.OuterAngle - IM_PI * 0.25f, def.OuterAngle); + window->DrawList->PathArcTo(ImLerp(border_r.Min, border_r.Max, def.SegmentN2) + ImVec2(0.5f, 0.5f) + def.InnerDir * rounding, rounding, def.OuterAngle, def.OuterAngle + IM_PI * 0.25f); + window->DrawList->PathStroke(GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_SeparatorActive), 0, ImMax(2.0f, border_size)); // Thicker than usual + } + if (g.Style.FrameBorderSize > 0 && !(window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar)) + { + float y = window->Pos.y + window->TitleBarHeight() - 1; + window->DrawList->AddLine(ImVec2(window->Pos.x + border_size, y), ImVec2(window->Pos.x + window->Size.x - border_size, y), GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Border), g.Style.FrameBorderSize); + } +} + +// Draw background and borders +// Draw and handle scrollbars +void ImGui::RenderWindowDecorations(ImGuiWindow* window, const ImRect& title_bar_rect, bool title_bar_is_highlight, int resize_grip_count, const ImU32 resize_grip_col[4], float resize_grip_draw_size) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style; + ImGuiWindowFlags flags = window->Flags; + + // Ensure that ScrollBar doesn't read last frame's SkipItems + IM_ASSERT(window->BeginCount == 0); + window->SkipItems = false; + + // Draw window + handle manual resize + // As we highlight the title bar when want_focus is set, multiple reappearing windows will have have their title bar highlighted on their reappearing frame. + const float window_rounding = window->WindowRounding; + const float window_border_size = window->WindowBorderSize; + if (window->Collapsed) + { + // Title bar only + float backup_border_size = style.FrameBorderSize; + g.Style.FrameBorderSize = window->WindowBorderSize; + ImU32 title_bar_col = GetColorU32((title_bar_is_highlight && !g.NavDisableHighlight) ? ImGuiCol_TitleBgActive : ImGuiCol_TitleBgCollapsed); + RenderFrame(title_bar_rect.Min, title_bar_rect.Max, title_bar_col, true, window_rounding); + g.Style.FrameBorderSize = backup_border_size; + } + else + { + // Window background + if (!(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoBackground)) + { + ImU32 bg_col = GetColorU32(GetWindowBgColorIdxFromFlags(flags)); + bool override_alpha = false; + float alpha = 1.0f; + if (g.NextWindowData.Flags & ImGuiNextWindowDataFlags_HasBgAlpha) + { + alpha = g.NextWindowData.BgAlphaVal; + override_alpha = true; + } + if (override_alpha) + bg_col = (bg_col & ~IM_COL32_A_MASK) | (IM_F32_TO_INT8_SAT(alpha) << IM_COL32_A_SHIFT); + window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(window->Pos + ImVec2(0, window->TitleBarHeight()), window->Pos + window->Size, bg_col, window_rounding, (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar) ? 0 : ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersBottom); + } + + // Title bar + if (!(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar)) + { + ImU32 title_bar_col = GetColorU32(title_bar_is_highlight ? ImGuiCol_TitleBgActive : ImGuiCol_TitleBg); + window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(title_bar_rect.Min, title_bar_rect.Max, title_bar_col, window_rounding, ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersTop); + } + + // Menu bar + if (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_MenuBar) + { + ImRect menu_bar_rect = window->MenuBarRect(); + menu_bar_rect.ClipWith(window->Rect()); // Soft clipping, in particular child window don't have minimum size covering the menu bar so this is useful for them. + window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(menu_bar_rect.Min + ImVec2(window_border_size, 0), menu_bar_rect.Max - ImVec2(window_border_size, 0), GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_MenuBarBg), (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar) ? window_rounding : 0.0f, ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersTop); + if (style.FrameBorderSize > 0.0f && menu_bar_rect.Max.y < window->Pos.y + window->Size.y) + window->DrawList->AddLine(menu_bar_rect.GetBL(), menu_bar_rect.GetBR(), GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Border), style.FrameBorderSize); + } + + // Scrollbars + if (window->ScrollbarX) + Scrollbar(ImGuiAxis_X); + if (window->ScrollbarY) + Scrollbar(ImGuiAxis_Y); + + // Render resize grips (after their input handling so we don't have a frame of latency) + if (!(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoResize)) + { + for (int resize_grip_n = 0; resize_grip_n < resize_grip_count; resize_grip_n++) + { + const ImGuiResizeGripDef& grip = resize_grip_def[resize_grip_n]; + const ImVec2 corner = ImLerp(window->Pos, window->Pos + window->Size, grip.CornerPosN); + window->DrawList->PathLineTo(corner + grip.InnerDir * ((resize_grip_n & 1) ? ImVec2(window_border_size, resize_grip_draw_size) : ImVec2(resize_grip_draw_size, window_border_size))); + window->DrawList->PathLineTo(corner + grip.InnerDir * ((resize_grip_n & 1) ? ImVec2(resize_grip_draw_size, window_border_size) : ImVec2(window_border_size, resize_grip_draw_size))); + window->DrawList->PathArcToFast(ImVec2(corner.x + grip.InnerDir.x * (window_rounding + window_border_size), corner.y + grip.InnerDir.y * (window_rounding + window_border_size)), window_rounding, grip.AngleMin12, grip.AngleMax12); + window->DrawList->PathFillConvex(resize_grip_col[resize_grip_n]); + } + } + + // Borders + RenderWindowOuterBorders(window); + } +} + +// Render title text, collapse button, close button +void ImGui::RenderWindowTitleBarContents(ImGuiWindow* window, const ImRect& title_bar_rect, const char* name, bool* p_open) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style; + ImGuiWindowFlags flags = window->Flags; + + const bool has_close_button = (p_open != NULL); + const bool has_collapse_button = !(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoCollapse) && (style.WindowMenuButtonPosition != ImGuiDir_None); + + // Close & Collapse button are on the Menu NavLayer and don't default focus (unless there's nothing else on that layer) + const ImGuiItemFlags item_flags_backup = g.CurrentItemFlags; + g.CurrentItemFlags |= ImGuiItemFlags_NoNavDefaultFocus; + window->DC.NavLayerCurrent = ImGuiNavLayer_Menu; + + // Layout buttons + // FIXME: Would be nice to generalize the subtleties expressed here into reusable code. + float pad_l = style.FramePadding.x; + float pad_r = style.FramePadding.x; + float button_sz = g.FontSize; + ImVec2 close_button_pos; + ImVec2 collapse_button_pos; + if (has_close_button) + { + pad_r += button_sz; + close_button_pos = ImVec2(title_bar_rect.Max.x - pad_r - style.FramePadding.x, title_bar_rect.Min.y); + } + if (has_collapse_button && style.WindowMenuButtonPosition == ImGuiDir_Right) + { + pad_r += button_sz; + collapse_button_pos = ImVec2(title_bar_rect.Max.x - pad_r - style.FramePadding.x, title_bar_rect.Min.y); + } + if (has_collapse_button && style.WindowMenuButtonPosition == ImGuiDir_Left) + { + collapse_button_pos = ImVec2(title_bar_rect.Min.x + pad_l - style.FramePadding.x, title_bar_rect.Min.y); + pad_l += button_sz; + } + + // Collapse button (submitting first so it gets priority when choosing a navigation init fallback) + if (has_collapse_button) + if (CollapseButton(window->GetID("#COLLAPSE"), collapse_button_pos)) + window->WantCollapseToggle = true; // Defer actual collapsing to next frame as we are too far in the Begin() function + + // Close button + if (has_close_button) + if (CloseButton(window->GetID("#CLOSE"), close_button_pos)) + *p_open = false; + + window->DC.NavLayerCurrent = ImGuiNavLayer_Main; + g.CurrentItemFlags = item_flags_backup; + + // Title bar text (with: horizontal alignment, avoiding collapse/close button, optional "unsaved document" marker) + // FIXME: Refactor text alignment facilities along with RenderText helpers, this is WAY too much messy code.. + const float marker_size_x = (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_UnsavedDocument) ? button_sz * 0.80f : 0.0f; + const ImVec2 text_size = CalcTextSize(name, NULL, true) + ImVec2(marker_size_x, 0.0f); + + // As a nice touch we try to ensure that centered title text doesn't get affected by visibility of Close/Collapse button, + // while uncentered title text will still reach edges correctly. + if (pad_l > style.FramePadding.x) + pad_l += g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x; + if (pad_r > style.FramePadding.x) + pad_r += g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x; + if (style.WindowTitleAlign.x > 0.0f && style.WindowTitleAlign.x < 1.0f) + { + float centerness = ImSaturate(1.0f - ImFabs(style.WindowTitleAlign.x - 0.5f) * 2.0f); // 0.0f on either edges, 1.0f on center + float pad_extend = ImMin(ImMax(pad_l, pad_r), title_bar_rect.GetWidth() - pad_l - pad_r - text_size.x); + pad_l = ImMax(pad_l, pad_extend * centerness); + pad_r = ImMax(pad_r, pad_extend * centerness); + } + + ImRect layout_r(title_bar_rect.Min.x + pad_l, title_bar_rect.Min.y, title_bar_rect.Max.x - pad_r, title_bar_rect.Max.y); + ImRect clip_r(layout_r.Min.x, layout_r.Min.y, ImMin(layout_r.Max.x + g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x, title_bar_rect.Max.x), layout_r.Max.y); + if (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_UnsavedDocument) + { + ImVec2 marker_pos; + marker_pos.x = ImClamp(layout_r.Min.x + (layout_r.GetWidth() - text_size.x) * style.WindowTitleAlign.x + text_size.x, layout_r.Min.x, layout_r.Max.x); + marker_pos.y = (layout_r.Min.y + layout_r.Max.y) * 0.5f; + if (marker_pos.x > layout_r.Min.x) + { + RenderBullet(window->DrawList, marker_pos, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text)); + clip_r.Max.x = ImMin(clip_r.Max.x, marker_pos.x - (int)(marker_size_x * 0.5f)); + } + } + //if (g.IO.KeyShift) window->DrawList->AddRect(layout_r.Min, layout_r.Max, IM_COL32(255, 128, 0, 255)); // [DEBUG] + //if (g.IO.KeyCtrl) window->DrawList->AddRect(clip_r.Min, clip_r.Max, IM_COL32(255, 128, 0, 255)); // [DEBUG] + RenderTextClipped(layout_r.Min, layout_r.Max, name, NULL, &text_size, style.WindowTitleAlign, &clip_r); +} + +void ImGui::UpdateWindowParentAndRootLinks(ImGuiWindow* window, ImGuiWindowFlags flags, ImGuiWindow* parent_window) +{ + window->ParentWindow = parent_window; + window->RootWindow = window->RootWindowForTitleBarHighlight = window->RootWindowForNav = window; + if (parent_window && (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow) && !(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Tooltip)) + window->RootWindow = parent_window->RootWindow; + if (parent_window && !(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Modal) && (flags & (ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow | ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup))) + window->RootWindowForTitleBarHighlight = parent_window->RootWindowForTitleBarHighlight; + while (window->RootWindowForNav->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NavFlattened) + { + IM_ASSERT(window->RootWindowForNav->ParentWindow != NULL); + window->RootWindowForNav = window->RootWindowForNav->ParentWindow; + } +} + +// Push a new Dear ImGui window to add widgets to. +// - A default window called "Debug" is automatically stacked at the beginning of every frame so you can use widgets without explicitly calling a Begin/End pair. +// - Begin/End can be called multiple times during the frame with the same window name to append content. +// - The window name is used as a unique identifier to preserve window information across frames (and save rudimentary information to the .ini file). +// You can use the "##" or "###" markers to use the same label with different id, or same id with different label. See documentation at the top of this file. +// - Return false when window is collapsed, so you can early out in your code. You always need to call ImGui::End() even if false is returned. +// - Passing 'bool* p_open' displays a Close button on the upper-right corner of the window, the pointed value will be set to false when the button is pressed. +bool ImGui::Begin(const char* name, bool* p_open, ImGuiWindowFlags flags) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style; + IM_ASSERT(name != NULL && name[0] != '\0'); // Window name required + IM_ASSERT(g.WithinFrameScope); // Forgot to call ImGui::NewFrame() + IM_ASSERT(g.FrameCountEnded != g.FrameCount); // Called ImGui::Render() or ImGui::EndFrame() and haven't called ImGui::NewFrame() again yet + + // Find or create + ImGuiWindow* window = FindWindowByName(name); + const bool window_just_created = (window == NULL); + if (window_just_created) + window = CreateNewWindow(name, flags); + + // Automatically disable manual moving/resizing when NoInputs is set + if ((flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoInputs) == ImGuiWindowFlags_NoInputs) + flags |= ImGuiWindowFlags_NoMove | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoResize; + + if (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NavFlattened) + IM_ASSERT(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow); + + const int current_frame = g.FrameCount; + const bool first_begin_of_the_frame = (window->LastFrameActive != current_frame); + window->IsFallbackWindow = (g.CurrentWindowStack.Size == 0 && g.WithinFrameScopeWithImplicitWindow); + + // Update the Appearing flag + bool window_just_activated_by_user = (window->LastFrameActive < current_frame - 1); // Not using !WasActive because the implicit "Debug" window would always toggle off->on + if (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup) + { + ImGuiPopupData& popup_ref = g.OpenPopupStack[g.BeginPopupStack.Size]; + window_just_activated_by_user |= (window->PopupId != popup_ref.PopupId); // We recycle popups so treat window as activated if popup id changed + window_just_activated_by_user |= (window != popup_ref.Window); + } + window->Appearing = window_just_activated_by_user; + if (window->Appearing) + SetWindowConditionAllowFlags(window, ImGuiCond_Appearing, true); + + // Update Flags, LastFrameActive, BeginOrderXXX fields + if (first_begin_of_the_frame) + { + window->Flags = (ImGuiWindowFlags)flags; + window->LastFrameActive = current_frame; + window->LastTimeActive = (float)g.Time; + window->BeginOrderWithinParent = 0; + window->BeginOrderWithinContext = (short)(g.WindowsActiveCount++); + } + else + { + flags = window->Flags; + } + + // Parent window is latched only on the first call to Begin() of the frame, so further append-calls can be done from a different window stack + ImGuiWindow* parent_window_in_stack = g.CurrentWindowStack.empty() ? NULL : g.CurrentWindowStack.back().Window; + ImGuiWindow* parent_window = first_begin_of_the_frame ? ((flags & (ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow | ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup)) ? parent_window_in_stack : NULL) : window->ParentWindow; + IM_ASSERT(parent_window != NULL || !(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow)); + + // We allow window memory to be compacted so recreate the base stack when needed. + if (window->IDStack.Size == 0) + window->IDStack.push_back(window->ID); + + // Add to stack + // We intentionally set g.CurrentWindow to NULL to prevent usage until when the viewport is set, then will call SetCurrentWindow() + ImGuiWindowStackData window_stack_data; + window_stack_data.Window = window; + window_stack_data.ParentLastItemDataBackup = g.LastItemData; + g.CurrentWindowStack.push_back(window_stack_data); + g.CurrentWindow = window; + window->DC.StackSizesOnBegin.SetToCurrentState(); + g.CurrentWindow = NULL; + + if (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup) + { + ImGuiPopupData& popup_ref = g.OpenPopupStack[g.BeginPopupStack.Size]; + popup_ref.Window = window; + g.BeginPopupStack.push_back(popup_ref); + window->PopupId = popup_ref.PopupId; + } + + // Update ->RootWindow and others pointers (before any possible call to FocusWindow) + if (first_begin_of_the_frame) + UpdateWindowParentAndRootLinks(window, flags, parent_window); + + // Process SetNextWindow***() calls + // (FIXME: Consider splitting the HasXXX flags into X/Y components + bool window_pos_set_by_api = false; + bool window_size_x_set_by_api = false, window_size_y_set_by_api = false; + if (g.NextWindowData.Flags & ImGuiNextWindowDataFlags_HasPos) + { + window_pos_set_by_api = (window->SetWindowPosAllowFlags & g.NextWindowData.PosCond) != 0; + if (window_pos_set_by_api && ImLengthSqr(g.NextWindowData.PosPivotVal) > 0.00001f) + { + // May be processed on the next frame if this is our first frame and we are measuring size + // FIXME: Look into removing the branch so everything can go through this same code path for consistency. + window->SetWindowPosVal = g.NextWindowData.PosVal; + window->SetWindowPosPivot = g.NextWindowData.PosPivotVal; + window->SetWindowPosAllowFlags &= ~(ImGuiCond_Once | ImGuiCond_FirstUseEver | ImGuiCond_Appearing); + } + else + { + SetWindowPos(window, g.NextWindowData.PosVal, g.NextWindowData.PosCond); + } + } + if (g.NextWindowData.Flags & ImGuiNextWindowDataFlags_HasSize) + { + window_size_x_set_by_api = (window->SetWindowSizeAllowFlags & g.NextWindowData.SizeCond) != 0 && (g.NextWindowData.SizeVal.x > 0.0f); + window_size_y_set_by_api = (window->SetWindowSizeAllowFlags & g.NextWindowData.SizeCond) != 0 && (g.NextWindowData.SizeVal.y > 0.0f); + SetWindowSize(window, g.NextWindowData.SizeVal, g.NextWindowData.SizeCond); + } + if (g.NextWindowData.Flags & ImGuiNextWindowDataFlags_HasScroll) + { + if (g.NextWindowData.ScrollVal.x >= 0.0f) + { + window->ScrollTarget.x = g.NextWindowData.ScrollVal.x; + window->ScrollTargetCenterRatio.x = 0.0f; + } + if (g.NextWindowData.ScrollVal.y >= 0.0f) + { + window->ScrollTarget.y = g.NextWindowData.ScrollVal.y; + window->ScrollTargetCenterRatio.y = 0.0f; + } + } + if (g.NextWindowData.Flags & ImGuiNextWindowDataFlags_HasContentSize) + window->ContentSizeExplicit = g.NextWindowData.ContentSizeVal; + else if (first_begin_of_the_frame) + window->ContentSizeExplicit = ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f); + if (g.NextWindowData.Flags & ImGuiNextWindowDataFlags_HasCollapsed) + SetWindowCollapsed(window, g.NextWindowData.CollapsedVal, g.NextWindowData.CollapsedCond); + if (g.NextWindowData.Flags & ImGuiNextWindowDataFlags_HasFocus) + FocusWindow(window); + if (window->Appearing) + SetWindowConditionAllowFlags(window, ImGuiCond_Appearing, false); + + // When reusing window again multiple times a frame, just append content (don't need to setup again) + if (first_begin_of_the_frame) + { + // Initialize + const bool window_is_child_tooltip = (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow) && (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Tooltip); // FIXME-WIP: Undocumented behavior of Child+Tooltip for pinned tooltip (#1345) + window->Active = true; + window->HasCloseButton = (p_open != NULL); + window->ClipRect = ImVec4(-FLT_MAX, -FLT_MAX, +FLT_MAX, +FLT_MAX); + window->IDStack.resize(1); + window->DrawList->_ResetForNewFrame(); + window->DC.CurrentTableIdx = -1; + + // Restore buffer capacity when woken from a compacted state, to avoid + if (window->MemoryCompacted) + GcAwakeTransientWindowBuffers(window); + + // Update stored window name when it changes (which can _only_ happen with the "###" operator, so the ID would stay unchanged). + // The title bar always display the 'name' parameter, so we only update the string storage if it needs to be visible to the end-user elsewhere. + bool window_title_visible_elsewhere = false; + if (g.NavWindowingListWindow != NULL && (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoNavFocus) == 0) // Window titles visible when using CTRL+TAB + window_title_visible_elsewhere = true; + if (window_title_visible_elsewhere && !window_just_created && strcmp(name, window->Name) != 0) + { + size_t buf_len = (size_t)window->NameBufLen; + window->Name = ImStrdupcpy(window->Name, &buf_len, name); + window->NameBufLen = (int)buf_len; + } + + // UPDATE CONTENTS SIZE, UPDATE HIDDEN STATUS + + // Update contents size from last frame for auto-fitting (or use explicit size) + const bool window_just_appearing_after_hidden_for_resize = (window->HiddenFramesCannotSkipItems > 0); + CalcWindowContentSizes(window, &window->ContentSize, &window->ContentSizeIdeal); + if (window->HiddenFramesCanSkipItems > 0) + window->HiddenFramesCanSkipItems--; + if (window->HiddenFramesCannotSkipItems > 0) + window->HiddenFramesCannotSkipItems--; + if (window->HiddenFramesForRenderOnly > 0) + window->HiddenFramesForRenderOnly--; + + // Hide new windows for one frame until they calculate their size + if (window_just_created && (!window_size_x_set_by_api || !window_size_y_set_by_api)) + window->HiddenFramesCannotSkipItems = 1; + + // Hide popup/tooltip window when re-opening while we measure size (because we recycle the windows) + // We reset Size/ContentSize for reappearing popups/tooltips early in this function, so further code won't be tempted to use the old size. + if (window_just_activated_by_user && (flags & (ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup | ImGuiWindowFlags_Tooltip)) != 0) + { + window->HiddenFramesCannotSkipItems = 1; + if (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize) + { + if (!window_size_x_set_by_api) + window->Size.x = window->SizeFull.x = 0.f; + if (!window_size_y_set_by_api) + window->Size.y = window->SizeFull.y = 0.f; + window->ContentSize = window->ContentSizeIdeal = ImVec2(0.f, 0.f); + } + } + + // SELECT VIEWPORT + // FIXME-VIEWPORT: In the docking/viewport branch, this is the point where we select the current viewport (which may affect the style) + SetCurrentWindow(window); + + // LOCK BORDER SIZE AND PADDING FOR THE FRAME (so that altering them doesn't cause inconsistencies) + + if (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow) + window->WindowBorderSize = style.ChildBorderSize; + else + window->WindowBorderSize = ((flags & (ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup | ImGuiWindowFlags_Tooltip)) && !(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Modal)) ? style.PopupBorderSize : style.WindowBorderSize; + window->WindowPadding = style.WindowPadding; + if ((flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow) && !(flags & (ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysUseWindowPadding | ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup)) && window->WindowBorderSize == 0.0f) + window->WindowPadding = ImVec2(0.0f, (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_MenuBar) ? style.WindowPadding.y : 0.0f); + + // Lock menu offset so size calculation can use it as menu-bar windows need a minimum size. + window->DC.MenuBarOffset.x = ImMax(ImMax(window->WindowPadding.x, style.ItemSpacing.x), g.NextWindowData.MenuBarOffsetMinVal.x); + window->DC.MenuBarOffset.y = g.NextWindowData.MenuBarOffsetMinVal.y; + + // Collapse window by double-clicking on title bar + // At this point we don't have a clipping rectangle setup yet, so we can use the title bar area for hit detection and drawing + if (!(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar) && !(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoCollapse)) + { + // We don't use a regular button+id to test for double-click on title bar (mostly due to legacy reason, could be fixed), so verify that we don't have items over the title bar. + ImRect title_bar_rect = window->TitleBarRect(); + if (g.HoveredWindow == window && g.HoveredId == 0 && g.HoveredIdPreviousFrame == 0 && IsMouseHoveringRect(title_bar_rect.Min, title_bar_rect.Max) && g.IO.MouseDoubleClicked[0]) + window->WantCollapseToggle = true; + if (window->WantCollapseToggle) + { + window->Collapsed = !window->Collapsed; + MarkIniSettingsDirty(window); + } + } + else + { + window->Collapsed = false; + } + window->WantCollapseToggle = false; + + // SIZE + + // Calculate auto-fit size, handle automatic resize + const ImVec2 size_auto_fit = CalcWindowAutoFitSize(window, window->ContentSizeIdeal); + bool use_current_size_for_scrollbar_x = window_just_created; + bool use_current_size_for_scrollbar_y = window_just_created; + if ((flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize) && !window->Collapsed) + { + // Using SetNextWindowSize() overrides ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize, so it can be used on tooltips/popups, etc. + if (!window_size_x_set_by_api) + { + window->SizeFull.x = size_auto_fit.x; + use_current_size_for_scrollbar_x = true; + } + if (!window_size_y_set_by_api) + { + window->SizeFull.y = size_auto_fit.y; + use_current_size_for_scrollbar_y = true; + } + } + else if (window->AutoFitFramesX > 0 || window->AutoFitFramesY > 0) + { + // Auto-fit may only grow window during the first few frames + // We still process initial auto-fit on collapsed windows to get a window width, but otherwise don't honor ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize when collapsed. + if (!window_size_x_set_by_api && window->AutoFitFramesX > 0) + { + window->SizeFull.x = window->AutoFitOnlyGrows ? ImMax(window->SizeFull.x, size_auto_fit.x) : size_auto_fit.x; + use_current_size_for_scrollbar_x = true; + } + if (!window_size_y_set_by_api && window->AutoFitFramesY > 0) + { + window->SizeFull.y = window->AutoFitOnlyGrows ? ImMax(window->SizeFull.y, size_auto_fit.y) : size_auto_fit.y; + use_current_size_for_scrollbar_y = true; + } + if (!window->Collapsed) + MarkIniSettingsDirty(window); + } + + // Apply minimum/maximum window size constraints and final size + window->SizeFull = CalcWindowSizeAfterConstraint(window, window->SizeFull); + window->Size = window->Collapsed && !(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow) ? window->TitleBarRect().GetSize() : window->SizeFull; + + // Decoration size + const float decoration_up_height = window->TitleBarHeight() + window->MenuBarHeight(); + + // POSITION + + // Popup latch its initial position, will position itself when it appears next frame + if (window_just_activated_by_user) + { + window->AutoPosLastDirection = ImGuiDir_None; + if ((flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup) != 0 && !(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Modal) && !window_pos_set_by_api) // FIXME: BeginPopup() could use SetNextWindowPos() + window->Pos = g.BeginPopupStack.back().OpenPopupPos; + } + + // Position child window + if (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow) + { + IM_ASSERT(parent_window && parent_window->Active); + window->BeginOrderWithinParent = (short)parent_window->DC.ChildWindows.Size; + parent_window->DC.ChildWindows.push_back(window); + if (!(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup) && !window_pos_set_by_api && !window_is_child_tooltip) + window->Pos = parent_window->DC.CursorPos; + } + + const bool window_pos_with_pivot = (window->SetWindowPosVal.x != FLT_MAX && window->HiddenFramesCannotSkipItems == 0); + if (window_pos_with_pivot) + SetWindowPos(window, window->SetWindowPosVal - window->Size * window->SetWindowPosPivot, 0); // Position given a pivot (e.g. for centering) + else if ((flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildMenu) != 0) + window->Pos = FindBestWindowPosForPopup(window); + else if ((flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup) != 0 && !window_pos_set_by_api && window_just_appearing_after_hidden_for_resize) + window->Pos = FindBestWindowPosForPopup(window); + else if ((flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Tooltip) != 0 && !window_pos_set_by_api && !window_is_child_tooltip) + window->Pos = FindBestWindowPosForPopup(window); + + // Calculate the range of allowed position for that window (to be movable and visible past safe area padding) + // When clamping to stay visible, we will enforce that window->Pos stays inside of visibility_rect. + ImGuiViewportP* viewport = (ImGuiViewportP*)(void*)GetMainViewport(); + ImRect viewport_rect(viewport->GetMainRect()); + ImRect viewport_work_rect(viewport->GetWorkRect()); + ImVec2 visibility_padding = ImMax(style.DisplayWindowPadding, style.DisplaySafeAreaPadding); + ImRect visibility_rect(viewport_work_rect.Min + visibility_padding, viewport_work_rect.Max - visibility_padding); + + // Clamp position/size so window stays visible within its viewport or monitor + // Ignore zero-sized display explicitly to avoid losing positions if a window manager reports zero-sized window when initializing or minimizing. + if (!window_pos_set_by_api && !(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow) && window->AutoFitFramesX <= 0 && window->AutoFitFramesY <= 0) + if (viewport_rect.GetWidth() > 0.0f && viewport_rect.GetHeight() > 0.0f) + ClampWindowRect(window, visibility_rect); + window->Pos = ImFloor(window->Pos); + + // Lock window rounding for the frame (so that altering them doesn't cause inconsistencies) + // Large values tend to lead to variety of artifacts and are not recommended. + window->WindowRounding = (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow) ? style.ChildRounding : ((flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup) && !(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Modal)) ? style.PopupRounding : style.WindowRounding; + + // For windows with title bar or menu bar, we clamp to FrameHeight(FontSize + FramePadding.y * 2.0f) to completely hide artifacts. + //if ((window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_MenuBar) || !(window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar)) + // window->WindowRounding = ImMin(window->WindowRounding, g.FontSize + style.FramePadding.y * 2.0f); + + // Apply window focus (new and reactivated windows are moved to front) + bool want_focus = false; + if (window_just_activated_by_user && !(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoFocusOnAppearing)) + { + if (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup) + want_focus = true; + else if ((flags & (ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow | ImGuiWindowFlags_Tooltip)) == 0) + want_focus = true; + } + + // Handle manual resize: Resize Grips, Borders, Gamepad + int border_held = -1; + ImU32 resize_grip_col[4] = {}; + const int resize_grip_count = g.IO.ConfigWindowsResizeFromEdges ? 2 : 1; // Allow resize from lower-left if we have the mouse cursor feedback for it. + const float resize_grip_draw_size = IM_FLOOR(ImMax(g.FontSize * 1.10f, window->WindowRounding + 1.0f + g.FontSize * 0.2f)); + if (!window->Collapsed) + if (UpdateWindowManualResize(window, size_auto_fit, &border_held, resize_grip_count, &resize_grip_col[0], visibility_rect)) + use_current_size_for_scrollbar_x = use_current_size_for_scrollbar_y = true; + window->ResizeBorderHeld = (signed char)border_held; + + // SCROLLBAR VISIBILITY + + // Update scrollbar visibility (based on the Size that was effective during last frame or the auto-resized Size). + if (!window->Collapsed) + { + // When reading the current size we need to read it after size constraints have been applied. + // When we use InnerRect here we are intentionally reading last frame size, same for ScrollbarSizes values before we set them again. + ImVec2 avail_size_from_current_frame = ImVec2(window->SizeFull.x, window->SizeFull.y - decoration_up_height); + ImVec2 avail_size_from_last_frame = window->InnerRect.GetSize() + window->ScrollbarSizes; + ImVec2 needed_size_from_last_frame = window_just_created ? ImVec2(0, 0) : window->ContentSize + window->WindowPadding * 2.0f; + float size_x_for_scrollbars = use_current_size_for_scrollbar_x ? avail_size_from_current_frame.x : avail_size_from_last_frame.x; + float size_y_for_scrollbars = use_current_size_for_scrollbar_y ? avail_size_from_current_frame.y : avail_size_from_last_frame.y; + //bool scrollbar_y_from_last_frame = window->ScrollbarY; // FIXME: May want to use that in the ScrollbarX expression? How many pros vs cons? + window->ScrollbarY = (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysVerticalScrollbar) || ((needed_size_from_last_frame.y > size_y_for_scrollbars) && !(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoScrollbar)); + window->ScrollbarX = (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysHorizontalScrollbar) || ((needed_size_from_last_frame.x > size_x_for_scrollbars - (window->ScrollbarY ? style.ScrollbarSize : 0.0f)) && !(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoScrollbar) && (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_HorizontalScrollbar)); + if (window->ScrollbarX && !window->ScrollbarY) + window->ScrollbarY = (needed_size_from_last_frame.y > size_y_for_scrollbars) && !(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoScrollbar); + window->ScrollbarSizes = ImVec2(window->ScrollbarY ? style.ScrollbarSize : 0.0f, window->ScrollbarX ? style.ScrollbarSize : 0.0f); + } + + // UPDATE RECTANGLES (1- THOSE NOT AFFECTED BY SCROLLING) + // Update various regions. Variables they depends on should be set above in this function. + // We set this up after processing the resize grip so that our rectangles doesn't lag by a frame. + + // Outer rectangle + // Not affected by window border size. Used by: + // - FindHoveredWindow() (w/ extra padding when border resize is enabled) + // - Begin() initial clipping rect for drawing window background and borders. + // - Begin() clipping whole child + const ImRect host_rect = ((flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow) && !(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup) && !window_is_child_tooltip) ? parent_window->ClipRect : viewport_rect; + const ImRect outer_rect = window->Rect(); + const ImRect title_bar_rect = window->TitleBarRect(); + window->OuterRectClipped = outer_rect; + window->OuterRectClipped.ClipWith(host_rect); + + // Inner rectangle + // Not affected by window border size. Used by: + // - InnerClipRect + // - ScrollToBringRectIntoView() + // - NavUpdatePageUpPageDown() + // - Scrollbar() + window->InnerRect.Min.x = window->Pos.x; + window->InnerRect.Min.y = window->Pos.y + decoration_up_height; + window->InnerRect.Max.x = window->Pos.x + window->Size.x - window->ScrollbarSizes.x; + window->InnerRect.Max.y = window->Pos.y + window->Size.y - window->ScrollbarSizes.y; + + // Inner clipping rectangle. + // Will extend a little bit outside the normal work region. + // This is to allow e.g. Selectable or CollapsingHeader or some separators to cover that space. + // Force round operator last to ensure that e.g. (int)(max.x-min.x) in user's render code produce correct result. + // Note that if our window is collapsed we will end up with an inverted (~null) clipping rectangle which is the correct behavior. + // Affected by window/frame border size. Used by: + // - Begin() initial clip rect + float top_border_size = (((flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_MenuBar) || !(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar)) ? style.FrameBorderSize : window->WindowBorderSize); + window->InnerClipRect.Min.x = ImFloor(0.5f + window->InnerRect.Min.x + ImMax(ImFloor(window->WindowPadding.x * 0.5f), window->WindowBorderSize)); + window->InnerClipRect.Min.y = ImFloor(0.5f + window->InnerRect.Min.y + top_border_size); + window->InnerClipRect.Max.x = ImFloor(0.5f + window->InnerRect.Max.x - ImMax(ImFloor(window->WindowPadding.x * 0.5f), window->WindowBorderSize)); + window->InnerClipRect.Max.y = ImFloor(0.5f + window->InnerRect.Max.y - window->WindowBorderSize); + window->InnerClipRect.ClipWithFull(host_rect); + + // Default item width. Make it proportional to window size if window manually resizes + if (window->Size.x > 0.0f && !(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Tooltip) && !(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize)) + window->ItemWidthDefault = ImFloor(window->Size.x * 0.65f); + else + window->ItemWidthDefault = ImFloor(g.FontSize * 16.0f); + + // SCROLLING + + // Lock down maximum scrolling + // The value of ScrollMax are ahead from ScrollbarX/ScrollbarY which is intentionally using InnerRect from previous rect in order to accommodate + // for right/bottom aligned items without creating a scrollbar. + window->ScrollMax.x = ImMax(0.0f, window->ContentSize.x + window->WindowPadding.x * 2.0f - window->InnerRect.GetWidth()); + window->ScrollMax.y = ImMax(0.0f, window->ContentSize.y + window->WindowPadding.y * 2.0f - window->InnerRect.GetHeight()); + + // Apply scrolling + window->Scroll = CalcNextScrollFromScrollTargetAndClamp(window); + window->ScrollTarget = ImVec2(FLT_MAX, FLT_MAX); + + // DRAWING + + // Setup draw list and outer clipping rectangle + IM_ASSERT(window->DrawList->CmdBuffer.Size == 1 && window->DrawList->CmdBuffer[0].ElemCount == 0); + window->DrawList->PushTextureID(g.Font->ContainerAtlas->TexID); + PushClipRect(host_rect.Min, host_rect.Max, false); + + // Draw modal window background (darkens what is behind them, all viewports) + const bool dim_bg_for_modal = (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Modal) && window == GetTopMostPopupModal() && window->HiddenFramesCannotSkipItems <= 0; + const bool dim_bg_for_window_list = g.NavWindowingTargetAnim && (window == g.NavWindowingTargetAnim->RootWindow); + if (dim_bg_for_modal || dim_bg_for_window_list) + { + const ImU32 dim_bg_col = GetColorU32(dim_bg_for_modal ? ImGuiCol_ModalWindowDimBg : ImGuiCol_NavWindowingDimBg, g.DimBgRatio); + window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(viewport_rect.Min, viewport_rect.Max, dim_bg_col); + } + + // Draw navigation selection/windowing rectangle background + if (dim_bg_for_window_list && window == g.NavWindowingTargetAnim) + { + ImRect bb = window->Rect(); + bb.Expand(g.FontSize); + if (!bb.Contains(viewport_rect)) // Avoid drawing if the window covers all the viewport anyway + window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(bb.Min, bb.Max, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_NavWindowingHighlight, g.NavWindowingHighlightAlpha * 0.25f), g.Style.WindowRounding); + } + + // Since 1.71, child window can render their decoration (bg color, border, scrollbars, etc.) within their parent to save a draw call. + // When using overlapping child windows, this will break the assumption that child z-order is mapped to submission order. + // We disable this when the parent window has zero vertices, which is a common pattern leading to laying out multiple overlapping child. + // We also disabled this when we have dimming overlay behind this specific one child. + // FIXME: More code may rely on explicit sorting of overlapping child window and would need to disable this somehow. Please get in contact if you are affected. + { + bool render_decorations_in_parent = false; + if ((flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow) && !(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup) && !window_is_child_tooltip) + if (window->DrawList->CmdBuffer.back().ElemCount == 0 && parent_window->DrawList->VtxBuffer.Size > 0) + render_decorations_in_parent = true; + if (render_decorations_in_parent) + window->DrawList = parent_window->DrawList; + + // Handle title bar, scrollbar, resize grips and resize borders + const ImGuiWindow* window_to_highlight = g.NavWindowingTarget ? g.NavWindowingTarget : g.NavWindow; + const bool title_bar_is_highlight = want_focus || (window_to_highlight && window->RootWindowForTitleBarHighlight == window_to_highlight->RootWindowForTitleBarHighlight); + RenderWindowDecorations(window, title_bar_rect, title_bar_is_highlight, resize_grip_count, resize_grip_col, resize_grip_draw_size); + + if (render_decorations_in_parent) + window->DrawList = &window->DrawListInst; + } + + // Draw navigation selection/windowing rectangle border + if (g.NavWindowingTargetAnim == window) + { + float rounding = ImMax(window->WindowRounding, g.Style.WindowRounding); + ImRect bb = window->Rect(); + bb.Expand(g.FontSize); + if (bb.Contains(viewport_rect)) // If a window fits the entire viewport, adjust its highlight inward + { + bb.Expand(-g.FontSize - 1.0f); + rounding = window->WindowRounding; + } + window->DrawList->AddRect(bb.Min, bb.Max, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_NavWindowingHighlight, g.NavWindowingHighlightAlpha), rounding, 0, 3.0f); + } + + // UPDATE RECTANGLES (2- THOSE AFFECTED BY SCROLLING) + + // Work rectangle. + // Affected by window padding and border size. Used by: + // - Columns() for right-most edge + // - TreeNode(), CollapsingHeader() for right-most edge + // - BeginTabBar() for right-most edge + const bool allow_scrollbar_x = !(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoScrollbar) && (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_HorizontalScrollbar); + const bool allow_scrollbar_y = !(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoScrollbar); + const float work_rect_size_x = (window->ContentSizeExplicit.x != 0.0f ? window->ContentSizeExplicit.x : ImMax(allow_scrollbar_x ? window->ContentSize.x : 0.0f, window->Size.x - window->WindowPadding.x * 2.0f - window->ScrollbarSizes.x)); + const float work_rect_size_y = (window->ContentSizeExplicit.y != 0.0f ? window->ContentSizeExplicit.y : ImMax(allow_scrollbar_y ? window->ContentSize.y : 0.0f, window->Size.y - window->WindowPadding.y * 2.0f - decoration_up_height - window->ScrollbarSizes.y)); + window->WorkRect.Min.x = ImFloor(window->InnerRect.Min.x - window->Scroll.x + ImMax(window->WindowPadding.x, window->WindowBorderSize)); + window->WorkRect.Min.y = ImFloor(window->InnerRect.Min.y - window->Scroll.y + ImMax(window->WindowPadding.y, window->WindowBorderSize)); + window->WorkRect.Max.x = window->WorkRect.Min.x + work_rect_size_x; + window->WorkRect.Max.y = window->WorkRect.Min.y + work_rect_size_y; + window->ParentWorkRect = window->WorkRect; + + // [LEGACY] Content Region + // FIXME-OBSOLETE: window->ContentRegionRect.Max is currently very misleading / partly faulty, but some BeginChild() patterns relies on it. + // Used by: + // - Mouse wheel scrolling + many other things + window->ContentRegionRect.Min.x = window->Pos.x - window->Scroll.x + window->WindowPadding.x; + window->ContentRegionRect.Min.y = window->Pos.y - window->Scroll.y + window->WindowPadding.y + decoration_up_height; + window->ContentRegionRect.Max.x = window->ContentRegionRect.Min.x + (window->ContentSizeExplicit.x != 0.0f ? window->ContentSizeExplicit.x : (window->Size.x - window->WindowPadding.x * 2.0f - window->ScrollbarSizes.x)); + window->ContentRegionRect.Max.y = window->ContentRegionRect.Min.y + (window->ContentSizeExplicit.y != 0.0f ? window->ContentSizeExplicit.y : (window->Size.y - window->WindowPadding.y * 2.0f - decoration_up_height - window->ScrollbarSizes.y)); + + // Setup drawing context + // (NB: That term "drawing context / DC" lost its meaning a long time ago. Initially was meant to hold transient data only. Nowadays difference between window-> and window->DC-> is dubious.) + window->DC.Indent.x = 0.0f + window->WindowPadding.x - window->Scroll.x; + window->DC.GroupOffset.x = 0.0f; + window->DC.ColumnsOffset.x = 0.0f; + window->DC.CursorStartPos = window->Pos + ImVec2(window->DC.Indent.x + window->DC.ColumnsOffset.x, decoration_up_height + window->WindowPadding.y - window->Scroll.y); + window->DC.CursorPos = window->DC.CursorStartPos; + window->DC.CursorPosPrevLine = window->DC.CursorPos; + window->DC.CursorMaxPos = window->DC.CursorStartPos; + window->DC.IdealMaxPos = window->DC.CursorStartPos; + window->DC.CurrLineSize = window->DC.PrevLineSize = ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f); + window->DC.CurrLineTextBaseOffset = window->DC.PrevLineTextBaseOffset = 0.0f; + + window->DC.NavLayerCurrent = ImGuiNavLayer_Main; + window->DC.NavLayersActiveMask = window->DC.NavLayersActiveMaskNext; + window->DC.NavLayersActiveMaskNext = 0x00; + window->DC.NavHideHighlightOneFrame = false; + window->DC.NavHasScroll = (window->ScrollMax.y > 0.0f); + + window->DC.MenuBarAppending = false; + window->DC.MenuColumns.Update(style.ItemSpacing.x, window_just_activated_by_user); + window->DC.TreeDepth = 0; + window->DC.TreeJumpToParentOnPopMask = 0x00; + window->DC.ChildWindows.resize(0); + window->DC.StateStorage = &window->StateStorage; + window->DC.CurrentColumns = NULL; + window->DC.LayoutType = ImGuiLayoutType_Vertical; + window->DC.ParentLayoutType = parent_window ? parent_window->DC.LayoutType : ImGuiLayoutType_Vertical; + window->DC.FocusCounterRegular = window->DC.FocusCounterTabStop = -1; + + window->DC.ItemWidth = window->ItemWidthDefault; + window->DC.TextWrapPos = -1.0f; // disabled + window->DC.ItemWidthStack.resize(0); + window->DC.TextWrapPosStack.resize(0); + + if (window->AutoFitFramesX > 0) + window->AutoFitFramesX--; + if (window->AutoFitFramesY > 0) + window->AutoFitFramesY--; + + // Apply focus (we need to call FocusWindow() AFTER setting DC.CursorStartPos so our initial navigation reference rectangle can start around there) + if (want_focus) + { + FocusWindow(window); + NavInitWindow(window, false); // <-- this is in the way for us to be able to defer and sort reappearing FocusWindow() calls + } + + // Title bar + if (!(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar)) + RenderWindowTitleBarContents(window, ImRect(title_bar_rect.Min.x + window->WindowBorderSize, title_bar_rect.Min.y, title_bar_rect.Max.x - window->WindowBorderSize, title_bar_rect.Max.y), name, p_open); + + // Clear hit test shape every frame + window->HitTestHoleSize.x = window->HitTestHoleSize.y = 0; + + // Pressing CTRL+C while holding on a window copy its content to the clipboard + // This works but 1. doesn't handle multiple Begin/End pairs, 2. recursing into another Begin/End pair - so we need to work that out and add better logging scope. + // Maybe we can support CTRL+C on every element? + /* + //if (g.NavWindow == window && g.ActiveId == 0) + if (g.ActiveId == window->MoveId) + if (g.IO.KeyCtrl && IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_C)) + LogToClipboard(); + */ + + // We fill last item data based on Title Bar/Tab, in order for IsItemHovered() and IsItemActive() to be usable after Begin(). + // This is useful to allow creating context menus on title bar only, etc. + g.LastItemData.ID = window->MoveId; + g.LastItemData.InFlags = g.CurrentItemFlags; + g.LastItemData.StatusFlags = IsMouseHoveringRect(title_bar_rect.Min, title_bar_rect.Max, false) ? ImGuiItemStatusFlags_HoveredRect : 0; + g.LastItemData.Rect = title_bar_rect; + +#ifdef IMGUI_ENABLE_TEST_ENGINE + if (!(window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar)) + IMGUI_TEST_ENGINE_ITEM_ADD(g.LastItemData.Rect, g.LastItemData.ID); +#endif + } + else + { + // Append + SetCurrentWindow(window); + } + + // Pull/inherit current state + window->DC.NavFocusScopeIdCurrent = (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow) ? parent_window->DC.NavFocusScopeIdCurrent : window->GetID("#FOCUSSCOPE"); // Inherit from parent only // -V595 + + PushClipRect(window->InnerClipRect.Min, window->InnerClipRect.Max, true); + + // Clear 'accessed' flag last thing (After PushClipRect which will set the flag. We want the flag to stay false when the default "Debug" window is unused) + window->WriteAccessed = false; + window->BeginCount++; + g.NextWindowData.ClearFlags(); + + // Update visibility + if (first_begin_of_the_frame) + { + if (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow) + { + // Child window can be out of sight and have "negative" clip windows. + // Mark them as collapsed so commands are skipped earlier (we can't manually collapse them because they have no title bar). + IM_ASSERT((flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar) != 0); + if (!(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize) && window->AutoFitFramesX <= 0 && window->AutoFitFramesY <= 0) // FIXME: Doesn't make sense for ChildWindow?? + if (!g.LogEnabled) + if (window->OuterRectClipped.Min.x >= window->OuterRectClipped.Max.x || window->OuterRectClipped.Min.y >= window->OuterRectClipped.Max.y) + window->HiddenFramesCanSkipItems = 1; + + // Hide along with parent or if parent is collapsed + if (parent_window && (parent_window->Collapsed || parent_window->HiddenFramesCanSkipItems > 0)) + window->HiddenFramesCanSkipItems = 1; + if (parent_window && (parent_window->Collapsed || parent_window->HiddenFramesCannotSkipItems > 0)) + window->HiddenFramesCannotSkipItems = 1; + } + + // Don't render if style alpha is 0.0 at the time of Begin(). This is arbitrary and inconsistent but has been there for a long while (may remove at some point) + if (style.Alpha <= 0.0f) + window->HiddenFramesCanSkipItems = 1; + + // Update the Hidden flag + window->Hidden = (window->HiddenFramesCanSkipItems > 0) || (window->HiddenFramesCannotSkipItems > 0) || (window->HiddenFramesForRenderOnly > 0); + + // Disable inputs for requested number of frames + if (window->DisableInputsFrames > 0) + { + window->DisableInputsFrames--; + window->Flags |= ImGuiWindowFlags_NoInputs; + } + + // Update the SkipItems flag, used to early out of all items functions (no layout required) + bool skip_items = false; + if (window->Collapsed || !window->Active || window->Hidden) + if (window->AutoFitFramesX <= 0 && window->AutoFitFramesY <= 0 && window->HiddenFramesCannotSkipItems <= 0) + skip_items = true; + window->SkipItems = skip_items; + } + + return !window->SkipItems; +} + +void ImGui::End() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + + // Error checking: verify that user hasn't called End() too many times! + if (g.CurrentWindowStack.Size <= 1 && g.WithinFrameScopeWithImplicitWindow) + { + IM_ASSERT_USER_ERROR(g.CurrentWindowStack.Size > 1, "Calling End() too many times!"); + return; + } + IM_ASSERT(g.CurrentWindowStack.Size > 0); + + // Error checking: verify that user doesn't directly call End() on a child window. + if (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow) + IM_ASSERT_USER_ERROR(g.WithinEndChild, "Must call EndChild() and not End()!"); + + // Close anything that is open + if (window->DC.CurrentColumns) + EndColumns(); + PopClipRect(); // Inner window clip rectangle + + // Stop logging + if (!(window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow)) // FIXME: add more options for scope of logging + LogFinish(); + + // Pop from window stack + g.LastItemData = g.CurrentWindowStack.back().ParentLastItemDataBackup; + g.CurrentWindowStack.pop_back(); + if (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup) + g.BeginPopupStack.pop_back(); + window->DC.StackSizesOnBegin.CompareWithCurrentState(); + SetCurrentWindow(g.CurrentWindowStack.Size == 0 ? NULL : g.CurrentWindowStack.back().Window); +} + +void ImGui::BringWindowToFocusFront(ImGuiWindow* window) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + IM_ASSERT(window == window->RootWindow); + + const int cur_order = window->FocusOrder; + IM_ASSERT(g.WindowsFocusOrder[cur_order] == window); + if (g.WindowsFocusOrder.back() == window) + return; + + const int new_order = g.WindowsFocusOrder.Size - 1; + for (int n = cur_order; n < new_order; n++) + { + g.WindowsFocusOrder[n] = g.WindowsFocusOrder[n + 1]; + g.WindowsFocusOrder[n]->FocusOrder--; + IM_ASSERT(g.WindowsFocusOrder[n]->FocusOrder == n); + } + g.WindowsFocusOrder[new_order] = window; + window->FocusOrder = (short)new_order; +} + +void ImGui::BringWindowToDisplayFront(ImGuiWindow* window) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* current_front_window = g.Windows.back(); + if (current_front_window == window || current_front_window->RootWindow == window) // Cheap early out (could be better) + return; + for (int i = g.Windows.Size - 2; i >= 0; i--) // We can ignore the top-most window + if (g.Windows[i] == window) + { + memmove(&g.Windows[i], &g.Windows[i + 1], (size_t)(g.Windows.Size - i - 1) * sizeof(ImGuiWindow*)); + g.Windows[g.Windows.Size - 1] = window; + break; + } +} + +void ImGui::BringWindowToDisplayBack(ImGuiWindow* window) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + if (g.Windows[0] == window) + return; + for (int i = 0; i < g.Windows.Size; i++) + if (g.Windows[i] == window) + { + memmove(&g.Windows[1], &g.Windows[0], (size_t)i * sizeof(ImGuiWindow*)); + g.Windows[0] = window; + break; + } +} + +// Moving window to front of display and set focus (which happens to be back of our sorted list) +void ImGui::FocusWindow(ImGuiWindow* window) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + + if (g.NavWindow != window) + { + g.NavWindow = window; + if (window && g.NavDisableMouseHover) + g.NavMousePosDirty = true; + g.NavId = window ? window->NavLastIds[0] : 0; // Restore NavId + g.NavFocusScopeId = 0; + g.NavIdIsAlive = false; + g.NavLayer = ImGuiNavLayer_Main; + g.NavInitRequest = g.NavMoveRequest = false; + NavUpdateAnyRequestFlag(); + //IMGUI_DEBUG_LOG("FocusWindow(\"%s\")\n", window ? window->Name : NULL); + } + + // Close popups if any + ClosePopupsOverWindow(window, false); + + // Move the root window to the top of the pile + IM_ASSERT(window == NULL || window->RootWindow != NULL); + ImGuiWindow* focus_front_window = window ? window->RootWindow : NULL; // NB: In docking branch this is window->RootWindowDockStop + ImGuiWindow* display_front_window = window ? window->RootWindow : NULL; + + // Steal active widgets. Some of the cases it triggers includes: + // - Focus a window while an InputText in another window is active, if focus happens before the old InputText can run. + // - When using Nav to activate menu items (due to timing of activating on press->new window appears->losing ActiveId) + if (g.ActiveId != 0 && g.ActiveIdWindow && g.ActiveIdWindow->RootWindow != focus_front_window) + if (!g.ActiveIdNoClearOnFocusLoss) + ClearActiveID(); + + // Passing NULL allow to disable keyboard focus + if (!window) + return; + + // Bring to front + BringWindowToFocusFront(focus_front_window); + if (((window->Flags | display_front_window->Flags) & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoBringToFrontOnFocus) == 0) + BringWindowToDisplayFront(display_front_window); +} + +void ImGui::FocusTopMostWindowUnderOne(ImGuiWindow* under_this_window, ImGuiWindow* ignore_window) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + + const int start_idx = ((under_this_window != NULL) ? FindWindowFocusIndex(under_this_window) : g.WindowsFocusOrder.Size) - 1; + for (int i = start_idx; i >= 0; i--) + { + // We may later decide to test for different NoXXXInputs based on the active navigation input (mouse vs nav) but that may feel more confusing to the user. + ImGuiWindow* window = g.WindowsFocusOrder[i]; + IM_ASSERT(window == window->RootWindow); + if (window != ignore_window && window->WasActive) + if ((window->Flags & (ImGuiWindowFlags_NoMouseInputs | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoNavInputs)) != (ImGuiWindowFlags_NoMouseInputs | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoNavInputs)) + { + ImGuiWindow* focus_window = NavRestoreLastChildNavWindow(window); + FocusWindow(focus_window); + return; + } + } + FocusWindow(NULL); +} + +// Important: this alone doesn't alter current ImDrawList state. This is called by PushFont/PopFont only. +void ImGui::SetCurrentFont(ImFont* font) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + IM_ASSERT(font && font->IsLoaded()); // Font Atlas not created. Did you call io.Fonts->GetTexDataAsRGBA32 / GetTexDataAsAlpha8 ? + IM_ASSERT(font->Scale > 0.0f); + g.Font = font; + g.FontBaseSize = ImMax(1.0f, g.IO.FontGlobalScale * g.Font->FontSize * g.Font->Scale); + g.FontSize = g.CurrentWindow ? g.CurrentWindow->CalcFontSize() : 0.0f; + + ImFontAtlas* atlas = g.Font->ContainerAtlas; + g.DrawListSharedData.TexUvWhitePixel = atlas->TexUvWhitePixel; + g.DrawListSharedData.TexUvLines = atlas->TexUvLines; + g.DrawListSharedData.Font = g.Font; + g.DrawListSharedData.FontSize = g.FontSize; +} + +void ImGui::PushFont(ImFont* font) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + if (!font) + font = GetDefaultFont(); + SetCurrentFont(font); + g.FontStack.push_back(font); + g.CurrentWindow->DrawList->PushTextureID(font->ContainerAtlas->TexID); +} + +void ImGui::PopFont() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + g.CurrentWindow->DrawList->PopTextureID(); + g.FontStack.pop_back(); + SetCurrentFont(g.FontStack.empty() ? GetDefaultFont() : g.FontStack.back()); +} + +void ImGui::PushItemFlag(ImGuiItemFlags option, bool enabled) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiItemFlags item_flags = g.CurrentItemFlags; + IM_ASSERT(item_flags == g.ItemFlagsStack.back()); + if (enabled) + item_flags |= option; + else + item_flags &= ~option; + g.CurrentItemFlags = item_flags; + g.ItemFlagsStack.push_back(item_flags); +} + +void ImGui::PopItemFlag() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + IM_ASSERT(g.ItemFlagsStack.Size > 1); // Too many calls to PopItemFlag() - we always leave a 0 at the bottom of the stack. + g.ItemFlagsStack.pop_back(); + g.CurrentItemFlags = g.ItemFlagsStack.back(); +} + +// BeginDisabled()/EndDisabled() +// - Those can be nested but this cannot be used to enable an already disabled section (a single BeginDisabled(true) in the stack is enough to keep things disabled) +// - Visually this is currently altering alpha, but it is expected that in a future styling system this would work differently. +// - Feedback welcome at https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/issues/211 +// - BeginDisabled(false) essentially does nothing useful but is provided to facilitate use of boolean expressions. If you can avoid calling BeginDisabled(False)/EndDisabled() best to avoid it. +// - Optimized shortcuts instead of PushStyleVar() + PushItemFlag() +void ImGui::BeginDisabled(bool disabled) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + bool was_disabled = (g.CurrentItemFlags & ImGuiItemFlags_Disabled) != 0; + if (!was_disabled && disabled) + { + g.DisabledAlphaBackup = g.Style.Alpha; + g.Style.Alpha *= g.Style.DisabledAlpha; // PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_Alpha, g.Style.Alpha * g.Style.DisabledAlpha); + } + if (was_disabled || disabled) + g.CurrentItemFlags |= ImGuiItemFlags_Disabled; + g.ItemFlagsStack.push_back(g.CurrentItemFlags); +} + +void ImGui::EndDisabled() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + bool was_disabled = (g.CurrentItemFlags & ImGuiItemFlags_Disabled) != 0; + //PopItemFlag(); + g.ItemFlagsStack.pop_back(); + g.CurrentItemFlags = g.ItemFlagsStack.back(); + if (was_disabled && (g.CurrentItemFlags & ImGuiItemFlags_Disabled) == 0) + g.Style.Alpha = g.DisabledAlphaBackup; //PopStyleVar(); +} + +// FIXME: Look into renaming this once we have settled the new Focus/Activation/TabStop system. +void ImGui::PushAllowKeyboardFocus(bool allow_keyboard_focus) +{ + PushItemFlag(ImGuiItemFlags_NoTabStop, !allow_keyboard_focus); +} + +void ImGui::PopAllowKeyboardFocus() +{ + PopItemFlag(); +} + +void ImGui::PushButtonRepeat(bool repeat) +{ + PushItemFlag(ImGuiItemFlags_ButtonRepeat, repeat); +} + +void ImGui::PopButtonRepeat() +{ + PopItemFlag(); +} + +void ImGui::PushTextWrapPos(float wrap_pos_x) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + window->DC.TextWrapPosStack.push_back(window->DC.TextWrapPos); + window->DC.TextWrapPos = wrap_pos_x; +} + +void ImGui::PopTextWrapPos() +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + window->DC.TextWrapPos = window->DC.TextWrapPosStack.back(); + window->DC.TextWrapPosStack.pop_back(); +} + +bool ImGui::IsWindowChildOf(ImGuiWindow* window, ImGuiWindow* potential_parent) +{ + if (window->RootWindow == potential_parent) + return true; + while (window != NULL) + { + if (window == potential_parent) + return true; + window = window->ParentWindow; + } + return false; +} + +bool ImGui::IsWindowAbove(ImGuiWindow* potential_above, ImGuiWindow* potential_below) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + for (int i = g.Windows.Size - 1; i >= 0; i--) + { + ImGuiWindow* candidate_window = g.Windows[i]; + if (candidate_window == potential_above) + return true; + if (candidate_window == potential_below) + return false; + } + return false; +} + +bool ImGui::IsWindowHovered(ImGuiHoveredFlags flags) +{ + IM_ASSERT((flags & ImGuiHoveredFlags_AllowWhenOverlapped) == 0); // Flags not supported by this function + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + if (g.HoveredWindow == NULL) + return false; + + if ((flags & ImGuiHoveredFlags_AnyWindow) == 0) + { + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + switch (flags & (ImGuiHoveredFlags_RootWindow | ImGuiHoveredFlags_ChildWindows)) + { + case ImGuiHoveredFlags_RootWindow | ImGuiHoveredFlags_ChildWindows: + if (g.HoveredWindow->RootWindow != window->RootWindow) + return false; + break; + case ImGuiHoveredFlags_RootWindow: + if (g.HoveredWindow != window->RootWindow) + return false; + break; + case ImGuiHoveredFlags_ChildWindows: + if (!IsWindowChildOf(g.HoveredWindow, window)) + return false; + break; + default: + if (g.HoveredWindow != window) + return false; + break; + } + } + + if (!IsWindowContentHoverable(g.HoveredWindow, flags)) + return false; + if (!(flags & ImGuiHoveredFlags_AllowWhenBlockedByActiveItem)) + if (g.ActiveId != 0 && !g.ActiveIdAllowOverlap && g.ActiveId != g.HoveredWindow->MoveId) + return false; + return true; +} + +bool ImGui::IsWindowFocused(ImGuiFocusedFlags flags) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + + if (flags & ImGuiFocusedFlags_AnyWindow) + return g.NavWindow != NULL; + + IM_ASSERT(g.CurrentWindow); // Not inside a Begin()/End() + switch (flags & (ImGuiFocusedFlags_RootWindow | ImGuiFocusedFlags_ChildWindows)) + { + case ImGuiFocusedFlags_RootWindow | ImGuiFocusedFlags_ChildWindows: + return g.NavWindow && g.NavWindow->RootWindow == g.CurrentWindow->RootWindow; + case ImGuiFocusedFlags_RootWindow: + return g.NavWindow == g.CurrentWindow->RootWindow; + case ImGuiFocusedFlags_ChildWindows: + return g.NavWindow && IsWindowChildOf(g.NavWindow, g.CurrentWindow); + default: + return g.NavWindow == g.CurrentWindow; + } +} + +// Can we focus this window with CTRL+TAB (or PadMenu + PadFocusPrev/PadFocusNext) +// Note that NoNavFocus makes the window not reachable with CTRL+TAB but it can still be focused with mouse or programmatically. +// If you want a window to never be focused, you may use the e.g. NoInputs flag. +bool ImGui::IsWindowNavFocusable(ImGuiWindow* window) +{ + return window->WasActive && window == window->RootWindow && !(window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoNavFocus); +} + +float ImGui::GetWindowWidth() +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GImGui->CurrentWindow; + return window->Size.x; +} + +float ImGui::GetWindowHeight() +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GImGui->CurrentWindow; + return window->Size.y; +} + +ImVec2 ImGui::GetWindowPos() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + return window->Pos; +} + +void ImGui::SetWindowPos(ImGuiWindow* window, const ImVec2& pos, ImGuiCond cond) +{ + // Test condition (NB: bit 0 is always true) and clear flags for next time + if (cond && (window->SetWindowPosAllowFlags & cond) == 0) + return; + + IM_ASSERT(cond == 0 || ImIsPowerOfTwo(cond)); // Make sure the user doesn't attempt to combine multiple condition flags. + window->SetWindowPosAllowFlags &= ~(ImGuiCond_Once | ImGuiCond_FirstUseEver | ImGuiCond_Appearing); + window->SetWindowPosVal = ImVec2(FLT_MAX, FLT_MAX); + + // Set + const ImVec2 old_pos = window->Pos; + window->Pos = ImFloor(pos); + ImVec2 offset = window->Pos - old_pos; + window->DC.CursorPos += offset; // As we happen to move the window while it is being appended to (which is a bad idea - will smear) let's at least offset the cursor + window->DC.CursorMaxPos += offset; // And more importantly we need to offset CursorMaxPos/CursorStartPos this so ContentSize calculation doesn't get affected. + window->DC.IdealMaxPos += offset; + window->DC.CursorStartPos += offset; +} + +void ImGui::SetWindowPos(const ImVec2& pos, ImGuiCond cond) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead(); + SetWindowPos(window, pos, cond); +} + +void ImGui::SetWindowPos(const char* name, const ImVec2& pos, ImGuiCond cond) +{ + if (ImGuiWindow* window = FindWindowByName(name)) + SetWindowPos(window, pos, cond); +} + +ImVec2 ImGui::GetWindowSize() +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead(); + return window->Size; +} + +void ImGui::SetWindowSize(ImGuiWindow* window, const ImVec2& size, ImGuiCond cond) +{ + // Test condition (NB: bit 0 is always true) and clear flags for next time + if (cond && (window->SetWindowSizeAllowFlags & cond) == 0) + return; + + IM_ASSERT(cond == 0 || ImIsPowerOfTwo(cond)); // Make sure the user doesn't attempt to combine multiple condition flags. + window->SetWindowSizeAllowFlags &= ~(ImGuiCond_Once | ImGuiCond_FirstUseEver | ImGuiCond_Appearing); + + // Set + if (size.x > 0.0f) + { + window->AutoFitFramesX = 0; + window->SizeFull.x = IM_FLOOR(size.x); + } + else + { + window->AutoFitFramesX = 2; + window->AutoFitOnlyGrows = false; + } + if (size.y > 0.0f) + { + window->AutoFitFramesY = 0; + window->SizeFull.y = IM_FLOOR(size.y); + } + else + { + window->AutoFitFramesY = 2; + window->AutoFitOnlyGrows = false; + } +} + +void ImGui::SetWindowSize(const ImVec2& size, ImGuiCond cond) +{ + SetWindowSize(GImGui->CurrentWindow, size, cond); +} + +void ImGui::SetWindowSize(const char* name, const ImVec2& size, ImGuiCond cond) +{ + if (ImGuiWindow* window = FindWindowByName(name)) + SetWindowSize(window, size, cond); +} + +void ImGui::SetWindowCollapsed(ImGuiWindow* window, bool collapsed, ImGuiCond cond) +{ + // Test condition (NB: bit 0 is always true) and clear flags for next time + if (cond && (window->SetWindowCollapsedAllowFlags & cond) == 0) + return; + window->SetWindowCollapsedAllowFlags &= ~(ImGuiCond_Once | ImGuiCond_FirstUseEver | ImGuiCond_Appearing); + + // Set + window->Collapsed = collapsed; +} + +void ImGui::SetWindowHitTestHole(ImGuiWindow* window, const ImVec2& pos, const ImVec2& size) +{ + IM_ASSERT(window->HitTestHoleSize.x == 0); // We don't support multiple holes/hit test filters + window->HitTestHoleSize = ImVec2ih(size); + window->HitTestHoleOffset = ImVec2ih(pos - window->Pos); +} + +void ImGui::SetWindowCollapsed(bool collapsed, ImGuiCond cond) +{ + SetWindowCollapsed(GImGui->CurrentWindow, collapsed, cond); +} + +bool ImGui::IsWindowCollapsed() +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead(); + return window->Collapsed; +} + +bool ImGui::IsWindowAppearing() +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead(); + return window->Appearing; +} + +void ImGui::SetWindowCollapsed(const char* name, bool collapsed, ImGuiCond cond) +{ + if (ImGuiWindow* window = FindWindowByName(name)) + SetWindowCollapsed(window, collapsed, cond); +} + +void ImGui::SetWindowFocus() +{ + FocusWindow(GImGui->CurrentWindow); +} + +void ImGui::SetWindowFocus(const char* name) +{ + if (name) + { + if (ImGuiWindow* window = FindWindowByName(name)) + FocusWindow(window); + } + else + { + FocusWindow(NULL); + } +} + +void ImGui::SetNextWindowPos(const ImVec2& pos, ImGuiCond cond, const ImVec2& pivot) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + IM_ASSERT(cond == 0 || ImIsPowerOfTwo(cond)); // Make sure the user doesn't attempt to combine multiple condition flags. + g.NextWindowData.Flags |= ImGuiNextWindowDataFlags_HasPos; + g.NextWindowData.PosVal = pos; + g.NextWindowData.PosPivotVal = pivot; + g.NextWindowData.PosCond = cond ? cond : ImGuiCond_Always; +} + +void ImGui::SetNextWindowSize(const ImVec2& size, ImGuiCond cond) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + IM_ASSERT(cond == 0 || ImIsPowerOfTwo(cond)); // Make sure the user doesn't attempt to combine multiple condition flags. + g.NextWindowData.Flags |= ImGuiNextWindowDataFlags_HasSize; + g.NextWindowData.SizeVal = size; + g.NextWindowData.SizeCond = cond ? cond : ImGuiCond_Always; +} + +void ImGui::SetNextWindowSizeConstraints(const ImVec2& size_min, const ImVec2& size_max, ImGuiSizeCallback custom_callback, void* custom_callback_user_data) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + g.NextWindowData.Flags |= ImGuiNextWindowDataFlags_HasSizeConstraint; + g.NextWindowData.SizeConstraintRect = ImRect(size_min, size_max); + g.NextWindowData.SizeCallback = custom_callback; + g.NextWindowData.SizeCallbackUserData = custom_callback_user_data; +} + +// Content size = inner scrollable rectangle, padded with WindowPadding. +// SetNextWindowContentSize(ImVec2(100,100) + ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize will always allow submitting a 100x100 item. +void ImGui::SetNextWindowContentSize(const ImVec2& size) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + g.NextWindowData.Flags |= ImGuiNextWindowDataFlags_HasContentSize; + g.NextWindowData.ContentSizeVal = ImFloor(size); +} + +void ImGui::SetNextWindowScroll(const ImVec2& scroll) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + g.NextWindowData.Flags |= ImGuiNextWindowDataFlags_HasScroll; + g.NextWindowData.ScrollVal = scroll; +} + +void ImGui::SetNextWindowCollapsed(bool collapsed, ImGuiCond cond) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + IM_ASSERT(cond == 0 || ImIsPowerOfTwo(cond)); // Make sure the user doesn't attempt to combine multiple condition flags. + g.NextWindowData.Flags |= ImGuiNextWindowDataFlags_HasCollapsed; + g.NextWindowData.CollapsedVal = collapsed; + g.NextWindowData.CollapsedCond = cond ? cond : ImGuiCond_Always; +} + +void ImGui::SetNextWindowFocus() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + g.NextWindowData.Flags |= ImGuiNextWindowDataFlags_HasFocus; +} + +void ImGui::SetNextWindowBgAlpha(float alpha) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + g.NextWindowData.Flags |= ImGuiNextWindowDataFlags_HasBgAlpha; + g.NextWindowData.BgAlphaVal = alpha; +} + +ImDrawList* ImGui::GetWindowDrawList() +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + return window->DrawList; +} + +ImFont* ImGui::GetFont() +{ + return GImGui->Font; +} + +float ImGui::GetFontSize() +{ + return GImGui->FontSize; +} + +ImVec2 ImGui::GetFontTexUvWhitePixel() +{ + return GImGui->DrawListSharedData.TexUvWhitePixel; +} + +void ImGui::SetWindowFontScale(float scale) +{ + IM_ASSERT(scale > 0.0f); + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + window->FontWindowScale = scale; + g.FontSize = g.DrawListSharedData.FontSize = window->CalcFontSize(); +} + +void ImGui::ActivateItem(ImGuiID id) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + g.NavNextActivateId = id; +} + +void ImGui::PushFocusScope(ImGuiID id) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + g.FocusScopeStack.push_back(window->DC.NavFocusScopeIdCurrent); + window->DC.NavFocusScopeIdCurrent = id; +} + +void ImGui::PopFocusScope() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + IM_ASSERT(g.FocusScopeStack.Size > 0); // Too many PopFocusScope() ? + window->DC.NavFocusScopeIdCurrent = g.FocusScopeStack.back(); + g.FocusScopeStack.pop_back(); +} + +void ImGui::SetKeyboardFocusHere(int offset) +{ + IM_ASSERT(offset >= -1); // -1 is allowed but not below + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + g.TabFocusRequestNextWindow = window; + g.TabFocusRequestNextCounterRegular = window->DC.FocusCounterRegular + 1 + offset; + g.TabFocusRequestNextCounterTabStop = INT_MAX; +} + +void ImGui::SetItemDefaultFocus() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + if (!window->Appearing) + return; + if (g.NavWindow == window->RootWindowForNav && (g.NavInitRequest || g.NavInitResultId != 0) && g.NavLayer == window->DC.NavLayerCurrent) + { + g.NavInitRequest = false; + g.NavInitResultId = g.LastItemData.ID; + g.NavInitResultRectRel = ImRect(g.LastItemData.Rect.Min - window->Pos, g.LastItemData.Rect.Max - window->Pos); + NavUpdateAnyRequestFlag(); + if (!IsItemVisible()) + SetScrollHereY(); + } +} + +void ImGui::SetStateStorage(ImGuiStorage* tree) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GImGui->CurrentWindow; + window->DC.StateStorage = tree ? tree : &window->StateStorage; +} + +ImGuiStorage* ImGui::GetStateStorage() +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GImGui->CurrentWindow; + return window->DC.StateStorage; +} + +void ImGui::PushID(const char* str_id) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + ImGuiID id = window->GetIDNoKeepAlive(str_id); + window->IDStack.push_back(id); +} + +void ImGui::PushID(const char* str_id_begin, const char* str_id_end) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + ImGuiID id = window->GetIDNoKeepAlive(str_id_begin, str_id_end); + window->IDStack.push_back(id); +} + +void ImGui::PushID(const void* ptr_id) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + ImGuiID id = window->GetIDNoKeepAlive(ptr_id); + window->IDStack.push_back(id); +} + +void ImGui::PushID(int int_id) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + ImGuiID id = window->GetIDNoKeepAlive(int_id); + window->IDStack.push_back(id); +} + +// Push a given id value ignoring the ID stack as a seed. +void ImGui::PushOverrideID(ImGuiID id) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + window->IDStack.push_back(id); +} + +// Helper to avoid a common series of PushOverrideID -> GetID() -> PopID() call +// (note that when using this pattern, TestEngine's "Stack Tool" will tend to not display the intermediate stack level. +// for that to work we would need to do PushOverrideID() -> ItemAdd() -> PopID() which would alter widget code a little more) +ImGuiID ImGui::GetIDWithSeed(const char* str, const char* str_end, ImGuiID seed) +{ + ImGuiID id = ImHashStr(str, str_end ? (str_end - str) : 0, seed); + ImGui::KeepAliveID(id); +#ifdef IMGUI_ENABLE_TEST_ENGINE + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + IMGUI_TEST_ENGINE_ID_INFO2(id, ImGuiDataType_String, str, str_end); +#endif + return id; +} + +void ImGui::PopID() +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GImGui->CurrentWindow; + IM_ASSERT(window->IDStack.Size > 1); // Too many PopID(), or could be popping in a wrong/different window? + window->IDStack.pop_back(); +} + +ImGuiID ImGui::GetID(const char* str_id) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GImGui->CurrentWindow; + return window->GetID(str_id); +} + +ImGuiID ImGui::GetID(const char* str_id_begin, const char* str_id_end) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GImGui->CurrentWindow; + return window->GetID(str_id_begin, str_id_end); +} + +ImGuiID ImGui::GetID(const void* ptr_id) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GImGui->CurrentWindow; + return window->GetID(ptr_id); +} + +bool ImGui::IsRectVisible(const ImVec2& size) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GImGui->CurrentWindow; + return window->ClipRect.Overlaps(ImRect(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + size)); +} + +bool ImGui::IsRectVisible(const ImVec2& rect_min, const ImVec2& rect_max) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GImGui->CurrentWindow; + return window->ClipRect.Overlaps(ImRect(rect_min, rect_max)); +} + + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] ERROR CHECKING +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// Helper function to verify ABI compatibility between caller code and compiled version of Dear ImGui. +// Verify that the type sizes are matching between the calling file's compilation unit and imgui.cpp's compilation unit +// If the user has inconsistent compilation settings, imgui configuration #define, packing pragma, etc. your user code +// may see different structures than what imgui.cpp sees, which is problematic. +// We usually require settings to be in imconfig.h to make sure that they are accessible to all compilation units involved with Dear ImGui. +bool ImGui::DebugCheckVersionAndDataLayout(const char* version, size_t sz_io, size_t sz_style, size_t sz_vec2, size_t sz_vec4, size_t sz_vert, size_t sz_idx) +{ + bool error = false; + if (strcmp(version, IMGUI_VERSION) != 0) { error = true; IM_ASSERT(strcmp(version, IMGUI_VERSION) == 0 && "Mismatched version string!"); } + if (sz_io != sizeof(ImGuiIO)) { error = true; IM_ASSERT(sz_io == sizeof(ImGuiIO) && "Mismatched struct layout!"); } + if (sz_style != sizeof(ImGuiStyle)) { error = true; IM_ASSERT(sz_style == sizeof(ImGuiStyle) && "Mismatched struct layout!"); } + if (sz_vec2 != sizeof(ImVec2)) { error = true; IM_ASSERT(sz_vec2 == sizeof(ImVec2) && "Mismatched struct layout!"); } + if (sz_vec4 != sizeof(ImVec4)) { error = true; IM_ASSERT(sz_vec4 == sizeof(ImVec4) && "Mismatched struct layout!"); } + if (sz_vert != sizeof(ImDrawVert)) { error = true; IM_ASSERT(sz_vert == sizeof(ImDrawVert) && "Mismatched struct layout!"); } + if (sz_idx != sizeof(ImDrawIdx)) { error = true; IM_ASSERT(sz_idx == sizeof(ImDrawIdx) && "Mismatched struct layout!"); } + return !error; +} + +static void ImGui::ErrorCheckNewFrameSanityChecks() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + + // Check user IM_ASSERT macro + // (IF YOU GET A WARNING OR COMPILE ERROR HERE: it means your assert macro is incorrectly defined! + // If your macro uses multiple statements, it NEEDS to be surrounded by a 'do { ... } while (0)' block. + // This is a common C/C++ idiom to allow multiple statements macros to be used in control flow blocks.) + // #define IM_ASSERT(EXPR) if (SomeCode(EXPR)) SomeMoreCode(); // Wrong! + // #define IM_ASSERT(EXPR) do { if (SomeCode(EXPR)) SomeMoreCode(); } while (0) // Correct! + if (true) IM_ASSERT(1); else IM_ASSERT(0); + + // Check user data + // (We pass an error message in the assert expression to make it visible to programmers who are not using a debugger, as most assert handlers display their argument) + IM_ASSERT(g.Initialized); + IM_ASSERT((g.IO.DeltaTime > 0.0f || g.FrameCount == 0) && "Need a positive DeltaTime!"); + IM_ASSERT((g.FrameCount == 0 || g.FrameCountEnded == g.FrameCount) && "Forgot to call Render() or EndFrame() at the end of the previous frame?"); + IM_ASSERT(g.IO.DisplaySize.x >= 0.0f && g.IO.DisplaySize.y >= 0.0f && "Invalid DisplaySize value!"); + IM_ASSERT(g.IO.Fonts->IsBuilt() && "Font Atlas not built! Make sure you called ImGui_ImplXXXX_NewFrame() function for renderer backend, which should call io.Fonts->GetTexDataAsRGBA32() / GetTexDataAsAlpha8()"); + IM_ASSERT(g.Style.CurveTessellationTol > 0.0f && "Invalid style setting!"); + IM_ASSERT(g.Style.CircleTessellationMaxError > 0.0f && "Invalid style setting!"); + IM_ASSERT(g.Style.Alpha >= 0.0f && g.Style.Alpha <= 1.0f && "Invalid style setting!"); // Allows us to avoid a few clamps in color computations + IM_ASSERT(g.Style.WindowMinSize.x >= 1.0f && g.Style.WindowMinSize.y >= 1.0f && "Invalid style setting."); + IM_ASSERT(g.Style.WindowMenuButtonPosition == ImGuiDir_None || g.Style.WindowMenuButtonPosition == ImGuiDir_Left || g.Style.WindowMenuButtonPosition == ImGuiDir_Right); + for (int n = 0; n < ImGuiKey_COUNT; n++) + IM_ASSERT(g.IO.KeyMap[n] >= -1 && g.IO.KeyMap[n] < IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.IO.KeysDown) && "io.KeyMap[] contains an out of bound value (need to be 0..512, or -1 for unmapped key)"); + + // Check: required key mapping (we intentionally do NOT check all keys to not pressure user into setting up everything, but Space is required and was only added in 1.60 WIP) + if (g.IO.ConfigFlags & ImGuiConfigFlags_NavEnableKeyboard) + IM_ASSERT(g.IO.KeyMap[ImGuiKey_Space] != -1 && "ImGuiKey_Space is not mapped, required for keyboard navigation."); + + // Check: the io.ConfigWindowsResizeFromEdges option requires backend to honor mouse cursor changes and set the ImGuiBackendFlags_HasMouseCursors flag accordingly. + if (g.IO.ConfigWindowsResizeFromEdges && !(g.IO.BackendFlags & ImGuiBackendFlags_HasMouseCursors)) + g.IO.ConfigWindowsResizeFromEdges = false; +} + +static void ImGui::ErrorCheckEndFrameSanityChecks() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + + // Verify that io.KeyXXX fields haven't been tampered with. Key mods should not be modified between NewFrame() and EndFrame() + // One possible reason leading to this assert is that your backends update inputs _AFTER_ NewFrame(). + // It is known that when some modal native windows called mid-frame takes focus away, some backends such as GLFW will + // send key release events mid-frame. This would normally trigger this assertion and lead to sheared inputs. + // We silently accommodate for this case by ignoring/ the case where all io.KeyXXX modifiers were released (aka key_mod_flags == 0), + // while still correctly asserting on mid-frame key press events. + const ImGuiKeyModFlags key_mod_flags = GetMergedKeyModFlags(); + IM_ASSERT((key_mod_flags == 0 || g.IO.KeyMods == key_mod_flags) && "Mismatching io.KeyCtrl/io.KeyShift/io.KeyAlt/io.KeySuper vs io.KeyMods"); + IM_UNUSED(key_mod_flags); + + // Recover from errors + //ErrorCheckEndFrameRecover(); + + // Report when there is a mismatch of Begin/BeginChild vs End/EndChild calls. Important: Remember that the Begin/BeginChild API requires you + // to always call End/EndChild even if Begin/BeginChild returns false! (this is unfortunately inconsistent with most other Begin* API). + if (g.CurrentWindowStack.Size != 1) + { + if (g.CurrentWindowStack.Size > 1) + { + IM_ASSERT_USER_ERROR(g.CurrentWindowStack.Size == 1, "Mismatched Begin/BeginChild vs End/EndChild calls: did you forget to call End/EndChild?"); + while (g.CurrentWindowStack.Size > 1) + End(); + } + else + { + IM_ASSERT_USER_ERROR(g.CurrentWindowStack.Size == 1, "Mismatched Begin/BeginChild vs End/EndChild calls: did you call End/EndChild too much?"); + } + } + + IM_ASSERT_USER_ERROR(g.GroupStack.Size == 0, "Missing EndGroup call!"); +} + +// Experimental recovery from incorrect usage of BeginXXX/EndXXX/PushXXX/PopXXX calls. +// Must be called during or before EndFrame(). +// This is generally flawed as we are not necessarily End/Popping things in the right order. +// FIXME: Can't recover from inside BeginTabItem/EndTabItem yet. +// FIXME: Can't recover from interleaved BeginTabBar/Begin +void ImGui::ErrorCheckEndFrameRecover(ImGuiErrorLogCallback log_callback, void* user_data) +{ + // PVS-Studio V1044 is "Loop break conditions do not depend on the number of iterations" + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + while (g.CurrentWindowStack.Size > 0) + { + while (g.CurrentTable && (g.CurrentTable->OuterWindow == g.CurrentWindow || g.CurrentTable->InnerWindow == g.CurrentWindow)) + { + if (log_callback) log_callback(user_data, "Recovered from missing EndTable() in '%s'", g.CurrentTable->OuterWindow->Name); + EndTable(); + } + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + IM_ASSERT(window != NULL); + while (g.CurrentTabBar != NULL) //-V1044 + { + if (log_callback) log_callback(user_data, "Recovered from missing EndTabBar() in '%s'", window->Name); + EndTabBar(); + } + while (window->DC.TreeDepth > 0) + { + if (log_callback) log_callback(user_data, "Recovered from missing TreePop() in '%s'", window->Name); + TreePop(); + } + while (g.GroupStack.Size > window->DC.StackSizesOnBegin.SizeOfGroupStack) + { + if (log_callback) log_callback(user_data, "Recovered from missing EndGroup() in '%s'", window->Name); + EndGroup(); + } + while (window->IDStack.Size > 1) + { + if (log_callback) log_callback(user_data, "Recovered from missing PopID() in '%s'", window->Name); + PopID(); + } + while (g.ColorStack.Size > window->DC.StackSizesOnBegin.SizeOfColorStack) + { + if (log_callback) log_callback(user_data, "Recovered from missing PopStyleColor() in '%s' for ImGuiCol_%s", window->Name, GetStyleColorName(g.ColorStack.back().Col)); + PopStyleColor(); + } + while (g.StyleVarStack.Size > window->DC.StackSizesOnBegin.SizeOfStyleVarStack) + { + if (log_callback) log_callback(user_data, "Recovered from missing PopStyleVar() in '%s'", window->Name); + PopStyleVar(); + } + while (g.FocusScopeStack.Size > window->DC.StackSizesOnBegin.SizeOfFocusScopeStack) + { + if (log_callback) log_callback(user_data, "Recovered from missing PopFocusScope() in '%s'", window->Name); + PopFocusScope(); + } + if (g.CurrentWindowStack.Size == 1) + { + IM_ASSERT(g.CurrentWindow->IsFallbackWindow); + break; + } + IM_ASSERT(window == g.CurrentWindow); + if (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow) + { + if (log_callback) log_callback(user_data, "Recovered from missing EndChild() for '%s'", window->Name); + EndChild(); + } + else + { + if (log_callback) log_callback(user_data, "Recovered from missing End() for '%s'", window->Name); + End(); + } + } +} + +// Save current stack sizes for later compare +void ImGuiStackSizes::SetToCurrentState() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + SizeOfIDStack = (short)window->IDStack.Size; + SizeOfColorStack = (short)g.ColorStack.Size; + SizeOfStyleVarStack = (short)g.StyleVarStack.Size; + SizeOfFontStack = (short)g.FontStack.Size; + SizeOfFocusScopeStack = (short)g.FocusScopeStack.Size; + SizeOfGroupStack = (short)g.GroupStack.Size; + SizeOfBeginPopupStack = (short)g.BeginPopupStack.Size; +} + +// Compare to detect usage errors +void ImGuiStackSizes::CompareWithCurrentState() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + IM_UNUSED(window); + + // Window stacks + // NOT checking: DC.ItemWidth, DC.TextWrapPos (per window) to allow user to conveniently push once and not pop (they are cleared on Begin) + IM_ASSERT(SizeOfIDStack == window->IDStack.Size && "PushID/PopID or TreeNode/TreePop Mismatch!"); + + // Global stacks + // For color, style and font stacks there is an incentive to use Push/Begin/Pop/.../End patterns, so we relax our checks a little to allow them. + IM_ASSERT(SizeOfGroupStack == g.GroupStack.Size && "BeginGroup/EndGroup Mismatch!"); + IM_ASSERT(SizeOfBeginPopupStack == g.BeginPopupStack.Size && "BeginPopup/EndPopup or BeginMenu/EndMenu Mismatch!"); + IM_ASSERT(SizeOfColorStack >= g.ColorStack.Size && "PushStyleColor/PopStyleColor Mismatch!"); + IM_ASSERT(SizeOfStyleVarStack >= g.StyleVarStack.Size && "PushStyleVar/PopStyleVar Mismatch!"); + IM_ASSERT(SizeOfFontStack >= g.FontStack.Size && "PushFont/PopFont Mismatch!"); + IM_ASSERT(SizeOfFocusScopeStack == g.FocusScopeStack.Size && "PushFocusScope/PopFocusScope Mismatch!"); +} + + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] LAYOUT +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// - ItemSize() +// - ItemAdd() +// - SameLine() +// - GetCursorScreenPos() +// - SetCursorScreenPos() +// - GetCursorPos(), GetCursorPosX(), GetCursorPosY() +// - SetCursorPos(), SetCursorPosX(), SetCursorPosY() +// - GetCursorStartPos() +// - Indent() +// - Unindent() +// - SetNextItemWidth() +// - PushItemWidth() +// - PushMultiItemsWidths() +// - PopItemWidth() +// - CalcItemWidth() +// - CalcItemSize() +// - GetTextLineHeight() +// - GetTextLineHeightWithSpacing() +// - GetFrameHeight() +// - GetFrameHeightWithSpacing() +// - GetContentRegionMax() +// - GetContentRegionMaxAbs() [Internal] +// - GetContentRegionAvail(), +// - GetWindowContentRegionMin(), GetWindowContentRegionMax() +// - GetWindowContentRegionWidth() +// - BeginGroup() +// - EndGroup() +// Also see in imgui_widgets: tab bars, columns. +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// Advance cursor given item size for layout. +// Register minimum needed size so it can extend the bounding box used for auto-fit calculation. +// See comments in ItemAdd() about how/why the size provided to ItemSize() vs ItemAdd() may often different. +void ImGui::ItemSize(const ImVec2& size, float text_baseline_y) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + if (window->SkipItems) + return; + + // We increase the height in this function to accommodate for baseline offset. + // In theory we should be offsetting the starting position (window->DC.CursorPos), that will be the topic of a larger refactor, + // but since ItemSize() is not yet an API that moves the cursor (to handle e.g. wrapping) enlarging the height has the same effect. + const float offset_to_match_baseline_y = (text_baseline_y >= 0) ? ImMax(0.0f, window->DC.CurrLineTextBaseOffset - text_baseline_y) : 0.0f; + const float line_height = ImMax(window->DC.CurrLineSize.y, size.y + offset_to_match_baseline_y); + + // Always align ourselves on pixel boundaries + //if (g.IO.KeyAlt) window->DrawList->AddRect(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + ImVec2(size.x, line_height), IM_COL32(255,0,0,200)); // [DEBUG] + window->DC.CursorPosPrevLine.x = window->DC.CursorPos.x + size.x; + window->DC.CursorPosPrevLine.y = window->DC.CursorPos.y; + window->DC.CursorPos.x = IM_FLOOR(window->Pos.x + window->DC.Indent.x + window->DC.ColumnsOffset.x); // Next line + window->DC.CursorPos.y = IM_FLOOR(window->DC.CursorPos.y + line_height + g.Style.ItemSpacing.y); // Next line + window->DC.CursorMaxPos.x = ImMax(window->DC.CursorMaxPos.x, window->DC.CursorPosPrevLine.x); + window->DC.CursorMaxPos.y = ImMax(window->DC.CursorMaxPos.y, window->DC.CursorPos.y - g.Style.ItemSpacing.y); + //if (g.IO.KeyAlt) window->DrawList->AddCircle(window->DC.CursorMaxPos, 3.0f, IM_COL32(255,0,0,255), 4); // [DEBUG] + + window->DC.PrevLineSize.y = line_height; + window->DC.CurrLineSize.y = 0.0f; + window->DC.PrevLineTextBaseOffset = ImMax(window->DC.CurrLineTextBaseOffset, text_baseline_y); + window->DC.CurrLineTextBaseOffset = 0.0f; + + // Horizontal layout mode + if (window->DC.LayoutType == ImGuiLayoutType_Horizontal) + SameLine(); +} + +void ImGui::ItemSize(const ImRect& bb, float text_baseline_y) +{ + ItemSize(bb.GetSize(), text_baseline_y); +} + +// Declare item bounding box for clipping and interaction. +// Note that the size can be different than the one provided to ItemSize(). Typically, widgets that spread over available surface +// declare their minimum size requirement to ItemSize() and provide a larger region to ItemAdd() which is used drawing/interaction. +bool ImGui::ItemAdd(const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id, const ImRect* nav_bb_arg, ImGuiItemAddFlags flags) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + + // Set item data + g.LastItemData.ID = id; + g.LastItemData.Rect = bb; + g.LastItemData.InFlags = g.CurrentItemFlags; + g.LastItemData.StatusFlags = ImGuiItemStatusFlags_None; + + // Directional navigation processing + if (id != 0) + { + // Runs prior to clipping early-out + // (a) So that NavInitRequest can be honored, for newly opened windows to select a default widget + // (b) So that we can scroll up/down past clipped items. This adds a small O(N) cost to regular navigation requests + // unfortunately, but it is still limited to one window. It may not scale very well for windows with ten of + // thousands of item, but at least NavMoveRequest is only set on user interaction, aka maximum once a frame. + // We could early out with "if (is_clipped && !g.NavInitRequest) return false;" but when we wouldn't be able + // to reach unclipped widgets. This would work if user had explicit scrolling control (e.g. mapped on a stick). + // We intentionally don't check if g.NavWindow != NULL because g.NavAnyRequest should only be set when it is non null. + // If we crash on a NULL g.NavWindow we need to fix the bug elsewhere. + window->DC.NavLayersActiveMaskNext |= (1 << window->DC.NavLayerCurrent); + if (g.NavId == id || g.NavAnyRequest) + if (g.NavWindow->RootWindowForNav == window->RootWindowForNav) + if (window == g.NavWindow || ((window->Flags | g.NavWindow->Flags) & ImGuiWindowFlags_NavFlattened)) + NavProcessItem(window, nav_bb_arg ? *nav_bb_arg : bb, id); + + // [DEBUG] Item Picker tool, when enabling the "extended" version we perform the check in ItemAdd() +#ifdef IMGUI_DEBUG_TOOL_ITEM_PICKER_EX + if (id == g.DebugItemPickerBreakId) + { + IM_DEBUG_BREAK(); + g.DebugItemPickerBreakId = 0; + } +#endif + } + g.NextItemData.Flags = ImGuiNextItemDataFlags_None; + +#ifdef IMGUI_ENABLE_TEST_ENGINE + if (id != 0) + IMGUI_TEST_ENGINE_ITEM_ADD(nav_bb_arg ? *nav_bb_arg : bb, id); +#endif + + // Clipping test + const bool is_clipped = IsClippedEx(bb, id, false); + if (is_clipped) + return false; + //if (g.IO.KeyAlt) window->DrawList->AddRect(bb.Min, bb.Max, IM_COL32(255,255,0,120)); // [DEBUG] + + // Tab stop handling (previously was using internal ItemFocusable() api) + // FIXME-NAV: We would now want to move this above the clipping test, but this would require being able to scroll and currently this would mean an extra frame. (#4079, #343) + if (flags & ImGuiItemAddFlags_Focusable) + ItemFocusable(window, id); + + // We need to calculate this now to take account of the current clipping rectangle (as items like Selectable may change them) + if (IsMouseHoveringRect(bb.Min, bb.Max)) + g.LastItemData.StatusFlags |= ImGuiItemStatusFlags_HoveredRect; + return true; +} + +// Gets back to previous line and continue with horizontal layout +// offset_from_start_x == 0 : follow right after previous item +// offset_from_start_x != 0 : align to specified x position (relative to window/group left) +// spacing_w < 0 : use default spacing if pos_x == 0, no spacing if pos_x != 0 +// spacing_w >= 0 : enforce spacing amount +void ImGui::SameLine(float offset_from_start_x, float spacing_w) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + if (window->SkipItems) + return; + + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + if (offset_from_start_x != 0.0f) + { + if (spacing_w < 0.0f) spacing_w = 0.0f; + window->DC.CursorPos.x = window->Pos.x - window->Scroll.x + offset_from_start_x + spacing_w + window->DC.GroupOffset.x + window->DC.ColumnsOffset.x; + window->DC.CursorPos.y = window->DC.CursorPosPrevLine.y; + } + else + { + if (spacing_w < 0.0f) spacing_w = g.Style.ItemSpacing.x; + window->DC.CursorPos.x = window->DC.CursorPosPrevLine.x + spacing_w; + window->DC.CursorPos.y = window->DC.CursorPosPrevLine.y; + } + window->DC.CurrLineSize = window->DC.PrevLineSize; + window->DC.CurrLineTextBaseOffset = window->DC.PrevLineTextBaseOffset; +} + +ImVec2 ImGui::GetCursorScreenPos() +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead(); + return window->DC.CursorPos; +} + +void ImGui::SetCursorScreenPos(const ImVec2& pos) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + window->DC.CursorPos = pos; + window->DC.CursorMaxPos = ImMax(window->DC.CursorMaxPos, window->DC.CursorPos); +} + +// User generally sees positions in window coordinates. Internally we store CursorPos in absolute screen coordinates because it is more convenient. +// Conversion happens as we pass the value to user, but it makes our naming convention confusing because GetCursorPos() == (DC.CursorPos - window.Pos). May want to rename 'DC.CursorPos'. +ImVec2 ImGui::GetCursorPos() +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead(); + return window->DC.CursorPos - window->Pos + window->Scroll; +} + +float ImGui::GetCursorPosX() +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead(); + return window->DC.CursorPos.x - window->Pos.x + window->Scroll.x; +} + +float ImGui::GetCursorPosY() +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead(); + return window->DC.CursorPos.y - window->Pos.y + window->Scroll.y; +} + +void ImGui::SetCursorPos(const ImVec2& local_pos) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + window->DC.CursorPos = window->Pos - window->Scroll + local_pos; + window->DC.CursorMaxPos = ImMax(window->DC.CursorMaxPos, window->DC.CursorPos); +} + +void ImGui::SetCursorPosX(float x) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + window->DC.CursorPos.x = window->Pos.x - window->Scroll.x + x; + window->DC.CursorMaxPos.x = ImMax(window->DC.CursorMaxPos.x, window->DC.CursorPos.x); +} + +void ImGui::SetCursorPosY(float y) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + window->DC.CursorPos.y = window->Pos.y - window->Scroll.y + y; + window->DC.CursorMaxPos.y = ImMax(window->DC.CursorMaxPos.y, window->DC.CursorPos.y); +} + +ImVec2 ImGui::GetCursorStartPos() +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead(); + return window->DC.CursorStartPos - window->Pos; +} + +void ImGui::Indent(float indent_w) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + window->DC.Indent.x += (indent_w != 0.0f) ? indent_w : g.Style.IndentSpacing; + window->DC.CursorPos.x = window->Pos.x + window->DC.Indent.x + window->DC.ColumnsOffset.x; +} + +void ImGui::Unindent(float indent_w) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + window->DC.Indent.x -= (indent_w != 0.0f) ? indent_w : g.Style.IndentSpacing; + window->DC.CursorPos.x = window->Pos.x + window->DC.Indent.x + window->DC.ColumnsOffset.x; +} + +// Affect large frame+labels widgets only. +void ImGui::SetNextItemWidth(float item_width) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + g.NextItemData.Flags |= ImGuiNextItemDataFlags_HasWidth; + g.NextItemData.Width = item_width; +} + +// FIXME: Remove the == 0.0f behavior? +void ImGui::PushItemWidth(float item_width) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + window->DC.ItemWidthStack.push_back(window->DC.ItemWidth); // Backup current width + window->DC.ItemWidth = (item_width == 0.0f ? window->ItemWidthDefault : item_width); + g.NextItemData.Flags &= ~ImGuiNextItemDataFlags_HasWidth; +} + +void ImGui::PushMultiItemsWidths(int components, float w_full) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style; + const float w_item_one = ImMax(1.0f, IM_FLOOR((w_full - (style.ItemInnerSpacing.x) * (components - 1)) / (float)components)); + const float w_item_last = ImMax(1.0f, IM_FLOOR(w_full - (w_item_one + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x) * (components - 1))); + window->DC.ItemWidthStack.push_back(window->DC.ItemWidth); // Backup current width + window->DC.ItemWidthStack.push_back(w_item_last); + for (int i = 0; i < components - 2; i++) + window->DC.ItemWidthStack.push_back(w_item_one); + window->DC.ItemWidth = (components == 1) ? w_item_last : w_item_one; + g.NextItemData.Flags &= ~ImGuiNextItemDataFlags_HasWidth; +} + +void ImGui::PopItemWidth() +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + window->DC.ItemWidth = window->DC.ItemWidthStack.back(); + window->DC.ItemWidthStack.pop_back(); +} + +// Calculate default item width given value passed to PushItemWidth() or SetNextItemWidth(). +// The SetNextItemWidth() data is generally cleared/consumed by ItemAdd() or NextItemData.ClearFlags() +float ImGui::CalcItemWidth() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + float w; + if (g.NextItemData.Flags & ImGuiNextItemDataFlags_HasWidth) + w = g.NextItemData.Width; + else + w = window->DC.ItemWidth; + if (w < 0.0f) + { + float region_max_x = GetContentRegionMaxAbs().x; + w = ImMax(1.0f, region_max_x - window->DC.CursorPos.x + w); + } + w = IM_FLOOR(w); + return w; +} + +// [Internal] Calculate full item size given user provided 'size' parameter and default width/height. Default width is often == CalcItemWidth(). +// Those two functions CalcItemWidth vs CalcItemSize are awkwardly named because they are not fully symmetrical. +// Note that only CalcItemWidth() is publicly exposed. +// The 4.0f here may be changed to match CalcItemWidth() and/or BeginChild() (right now we have a mismatch which is harmless but undesirable) +ImVec2 ImGui::CalcItemSize(ImVec2 size, float default_w, float default_h) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GImGui->CurrentWindow; + + ImVec2 region_max; + if (size.x < 0.0f || size.y < 0.0f) + region_max = GetContentRegionMaxAbs(); + + if (size.x == 0.0f) + size.x = default_w; + else if (size.x < 0.0f) + size.x = ImMax(4.0f, region_max.x - window->DC.CursorPos.x + size.x); + + if (size.y == 0.0f) + size.y = default_h; + else if (size.y < 0.0f) + size.y = ImMax(4.0f, region_max.y - window->DC.CursorPos.y + size.y); + + return size; +} + +float ImGui::GetTextLineHeight() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + return g.FontSize; +} + +float ImGui::GetTextLineHeightWithSpacing() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + return g.FontSize + g.Style.ItemSpacing.y; +} + +float ImGui::GetFrameHeight() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + return g.FontSize + g.Style.FramePadding.y * 2.0f; +} + +float ImGui::GetFrameHeightWithSpacing() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + return g.FontSize + g.Style.FramePadding.y * 2.0f + g.Style.ItemSpacing.y; +} + +// FIXME: All the Contents Region function are messy or misleading. WE WILL AIM TO OBSOLETE ALL OF THEM WITH A NEW "WORK RECT" API. Thanks for your patience! + +// FIXME: This is in window space (not screen space!). +ImVec2 ImGui::GetContentRegionMax() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + ImVec2 mx = window->ContentRegionRect.Max - window->Pos; + if (window->DC.CurrentColumns || g.CurrentTable) + mx.x = window->WorkRect.Max.x - window->Pos.x; + return mx; +} + +// [Internal] Absolute coordinate. Saner. This is not exposed until we finishing refactoring work rect features. +ImVec2 ImGui::GetContentRegionMaxAbs() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + ImVec2 mx = window->ContentRegionRect.Max; + if (window->DC.CurrentColumns || g.CurrentTable) + mx.x = window->WorkRect.Max.x; + return mx; +} + +ImVec2 ImGui::GetContentRegionAvail() +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GImGui->CurrentWindow; + return GetContentRegionMaxAbs() - window->DC.CursorPos; +} + +// In window space (not screen space!) +ImVec2 ImGui::GetWindowContentRegionMin() +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GImGui->CurrentWindow; + return window->ContentRegionRect.Min - window->Pos; +} + +ImVec2 ImGui::GetWindowContentRegionMax() +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GImGui->CurrentWindow; + return window->ContentRegionRect.Max - window->Pos; +} + +float ImGui::GetWindowContentRegionWidth() +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GImGui->CurrentWindow; + return window->ContentRegionRect.GetWidth(); +} + +// Lock horizontal starting position + capture group bounding box into one "item" (so you can use IsItemHovered() or layout primitives such as SameLine() on whole group, etc.) +// Groups are currently a mishmash of functionalities which should perhaps be clarified and separated. +void ImGui::BeginGroup() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + + g.GroupStack.resize(g.GroupStack.Size + 1); + ImGuiGroupData& group_data = g.GroupStack.back(); + group_data.WindowID = window->ID; + group_data.BackupCursorPos = window->DC.CursorPos; + group_data.BackupCursorMaxPos = window->DC.CursorMaxPos; + group_data.BackupIndent = window->DC.Indent; + group_data.BackupGroupOffset = window->DC.GroupOffset; + group_data.BackupCurrLineSize = window->DC.CurrLineSize; + group_data.BackupCurrLineTextBaseOffset = window->DC.CurrLineTextBaseOffset; + group_data.BackupActiveIdIsAlive = g.ActiveIdIsAlive; + group_data.BackupHoveredIdIsAlive = g.HoveredId != 0; + group_data.BackupActiveIdPreviousFrameIsAlive = g.ActiveIdPreviousFrameIsAlive; + group_data.EmitItem = true; + + window->DC.GroupOffset.x = window->DC.CursorPos.x - window->Pos.x - window->DC.ColumnsOffset.x; + window->DC.Indent = window->DC.GroupOffset; + window->DC.CursorMaxPos = window->DC.CursorPos; + window->DC.CurrLineSize = ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f); + if (g.LogEnabled) + g.LogLinePosY = -FLT_MAX; // To enforce a carriage return +} + +void ImGui::EndGroup() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + IM_ASSERT(g.GroupStack.Size > 0); // Mismatched BeginGroup()/EndGroup() calls + + ImGuiGroupData& group_data = g.GroupStack.back(); + IM_ASSERT(group_data.WindowID == window->ID); // EndGroup() in wrong window? + + ImRect group_bb(group_data.BackupCursorPos, ImMax(window->DC.CursorMaxPos, group_data.BackupCursorPos)); + + window->DC.CursorPos = group_data.BackupCursorPos; + window->DC.CursorMaxPos = ImMax(group_data.BackupCursorMaxPos, window->DC.CursorMaxPos); + window->DC.Indent = group_data.BackupIndent; + window->DC.GroupOffset = group_data.BackupGroupOffset; + window->DC.CurrLineSize = group_data.BackupCurrLineSize; + window->DC.CurrLineTextBaseOffset = group_data.BackupCurrLineTextBaseOffset; + if (g.LogEnabled) + g.LogLinePosY = -FLT_MAX; // To enforce a carriage return + + if (!group_data.EmitItem) + { + g.GroupStack.pop_back(); + return; + } + + window->DC.CurrLineTextBaseOffset = ImMax(window->DC.PrevLineTextBaseOffset, group_data.BackupCurrLineTextBaseOffset); // FIXME: Incorrect, we should grab the base offset from the *first line* of the group but it is hard to obtain now. + ItemSize(group_bb.GetSize()); + ItemAdd(group_bb, 0); + + // If the current ActiveId was declared within the boundary of our group, we copy it to LastItemId so IsItemActive(), IsItemDeactivated() etc. will be functional on the entire group. + // It would be be neater if we replaced window.DC.LastItemId by e.g. 'bool LastItemIsActive', but would put a little more burden on individual widgets. + // Also if you grep for LastItemId you'll notice it is only used in that context. + // (The two tests not the same because ActiveIdIsAlive is an ID itself, in order to be able to handle ActiveId being overwritten during the frame.) + const bool group_contains_curr_active_id = (group_data.BackupActiveIdIsAlive != g.ActiveId) && (g.ActiveIdIsAlive == g.ActiveId) && g.ActiveId; + const bool group_contains_prev_active_id = (group_data.BackupActiveIdPreviousFrameIsAlive == false) && (g.ActiveIdPreviousFrameIsAlive == true); + if (group_contains_curr_active_id) + g.LastItemData.ID = g.ActiveId; + else if (group_contains_prev_active_id) + g.LastItemData.ID = g.ActiveIdPreviousFrame; + g.LastItemData.Rect = group_bb; + + // Forward Hovered flag + const bool group_contains_curr_hovered_id = (group_data.BackupHoveredIdIsAlive == false) && g.HoveredId != 0; + if (group_contains_curr_hovered_id) + g.LastItemData.StatusFlags |= ImGuiItemStatusFlags_HoveredWindow; + + // Forward Edited flag + if (group_contains_curr_active_id && g.ActiveIdHasBeenEditedThisFrame) + g.LastItemData.StatusFlags |= ImGuiItemStatusFlags_Edited; + + // Forward Deactivated flag + g.LastItemData.StatusFlags |= ImGuiItemStatusFlags_HasDeactivated; + if (group_contains_prev_active_id && g.ActiveId != g.ActiveIdPreviousFrame) + g.LastItemData.StatusFlags |= ImGuiItemStatusFlags_Deactivated; + + g.GroupStack.pop_back(); + //window->DrawList->AddRect(group_bb.Min, group_bb.Max, IM_COL32(255,0,255,255)); // [Debug] +} + + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] SCROLLING +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// Helper to snap on edges when aiming at an item very close to the edge, +// So the difference between WindowPadding and ItemSpacing will be in the visible area after scrolling. +// When we refactor the scrolling API this may be configurable with a flag? +// Note that the effect for this won't be visible on X axis with default Style settings as WindowPadding.x == ItemSpacing.x by default. +static float CalcScrollEdgeSnap(float target, float snap_min, float snap_max, float snap_threshold, float center_ratio) +{ + if (target <= snap_min + snap_threshold) + return ImLerp(snap_min, target, center_ratio); + if (target >= snap_max - snap_threshold) + return ImLerp(target, snap_max, center_ratio); + return target; +} + +static ImVec2 CalcNextScrollFromScrollTargetAndClamp(ImGuiWindow* window) +{ + ImVec2 scroll = window->Scroll; + if (window->ScrollTarget.x < FLT_MAX) + { + float decoration_total_width = window->ScrollbarSizes.x; + float center_x_ratio = window->ScrollTargetCenterRatio.x; + float scroll_target_x = window->ScrollTarget.x; + if (window->ScrollTargetEdgeSnapDist.x > 0.0f) + { + float snap_x_min = 0.0f; + float snap_x_max = window->ScrollMax.x + window->SizeFull.x - decoration_total_width; + scroll_target_x = CalcScrollEdgeSnap(scroll_target_x, snap_x_min, snap_x_max, window->ScrollTargetEdgeSnapDist.x, center_x_ratio); + } + scroll.x = scroll_target_x - center_x_ratio * (window->SizeFull.x - decoration_total_width); + } + if (window->ScrollTarget.y < FLT_MAX) + { + float decoration_total_height = window->TitleBarHeight() + window->MenuBarHeight() + window->ScrollbarSizes.y; + float center_y_ratio = window->ScrollTargetCenterRatio.y; + float scroll_target_y = window->ScrollTarget.y; + if (window->ScrollTargetEdgeSnapDist.y > 0.0f) + { + float snap_y_min = 0.0f; + float snap_y_max = window->ScrollMax.y + window->SizeFull.y - decoration_total_height; + scroll_target_y = CalcScrollEdgeSnap(scroll_target_y, snap_y_min, snap_y_max, window->ScrollTargetEdgeSnapDist.y, center_y_ratio); + } + scroll.y = scroll_target_y - center_y_ratio * (window->SizeFull.y - decoration_total_height); + } + scroll.x = IM_FLOOR(ImMax(scroll.x, 0.0f)); + scroll.y = IM_FLOOR(ImMax(scroll.y, 0.0f)); + if (!window->Collapsed && !window->SkipItems) + { + scroll.x = ImMin(scroll.x, window->ScrollMax.x); + scroll.y = ImMin(scroll.y, window->ScrollMax.y); + } + return scroll; +} + +// Scroll to keep newly navigated item fully into view +ImVec2 ImGui::ScrollToBringRectIntoView(ImGuiWindow* window, const ImRect& item_rect) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImRect window_rect(window->InnerRect.Min - ImVec2(1, 1), window->InnerRect.Max + ImVec2(1, 1)); + //GetForegroundDrawList(window)->AddRect(window_rect.Min, window_rect.Max, IM_COL32_WHITE); // [DEBUG] + + ImVec2 delta_scroll; + if (!window_rect.Contains(item_rect)) + { + if (window->ScrollbarX && item_rect.Min.x < window_rect.Min.x) + SetScrollFromPosX(window, item_rect.Min.x - window->Pos.x - g.Style.ItemSpacing.x, 0.0f); + else if (window->ScrollbarX && item_rect.Max.x >= window_rect.Max.x) + SetScrollFromPosX(window, item_rect.Max.x - window->Pos.x + g.Style.ItemSpacing.x, 1.0f); + if (item_rect.Min.y < window_rect.Min.y) + SetScrollFromPosY(window, item_rect.Min.y - window->Pos.y - g.Style.ItemSpacing.y, 0.0f); + else if (item_rect.Max.y >= window_rect.Max.y) + SetScrollFromPosY(window, item_rect.Max.y - window->Pos.y + g.Style.ItemSpacing.y, 1.0f); + + ImVec2 next_scroll = CalcNextScrollFromScrollTargetAndClamp(window); + delta_scroll = next_scroll - window->Scroll; + } + + // Also scroll parent window to keep us into view if necessary + if (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow) + delta_scroll += ScrollToBringRectIntoView(window->ParentWindow, ImRect(item_rect.Min - delta_scroll, item_rect.Max - delta_scroll)); + + return delta_scroll; +} + +float ImGui::GetScrollX() +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GImGui->CurrentWindow; + return window->Scroll.x; +} + +float ImGui::GetScrollY() +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GImGui->CurrentWindow; + return window->Scroll.y; +} + +float ImGui::GetScrollMaxX() +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GImGui->CurrentWindow; + return window->ScrollMax.x; +} + +float ImGui::GetScrollMaxY() +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GImGui->CurrentWindow; + return window->ScrollMax.y; +} + +void ImGui::SetScrollX(ImGuiWindow* window, float scroll_x) +{ + window->ScrollTarget.x = scroll_x; + window->ScrollTargetCenterRatio.x = 0.0f; + window->ScrollTargetEdgeSnapDist.x = 0.0f; +} + +void ImGui::SetScrollY(ImGuiWindow* window, float scroll_y) +{ + window->ScrollTarget.y = scroll_y; + window->ScrollTargetCenterRatio.y = 0.0f; + window->ScrollTargetEdgeSnapDist.y = 0.0f; +} + +void ImGui::SetScrollX(float scroll_x) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + SetScrollX(g.CurrentWindow, scroll_x); +} + +void ImGui::SetScrollY(float scroll_y) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + SetScrollY(g.CurrentWindow, scroll_y); +} + +// Note that a local position will vary depending on initial scroll value, +// This is a little bit confusing so bear with us: +// - local_pos = (absolution_pos - window->Pos) +// - So local_x/local_y are 0.0f for a position at the upper-left corner of a window, +// and generally local_x/local_y are >(padding+decoration) && <(size-padding-decoration) when in the visible area. +// - They mostly exists because of legacy API. +// Following the rules above, when trying to work with scrolling code, consider that: +// - SetScrollFromPosY(0.0f) == SetScrollY(0.0f + scroll.y) == has no effect! +// - SetScrollFromPosY(-scroll.y) == SetScrollY(-scroll.y + scroll.y) == SetScrollY(0.0f) == reset scroll. Of course writing SetScrollY(0.0f) directly then makes more sense +// We store a target position so centering and clamping can occur on the next frame when we are guaranteed to have a known window size +void ImGui::SetScrollFromPosX(ImGuiWindow* window, float local_x, float center_x_ratio) +{ + IM_ASSERT(center_x_ratio >= 0.0f && center_x_ratio <= 1.0f); + window->ScrollTarget.x = IM_FLOOR(local_x + window->Scroll.x); // Convert local position to scroll offset + window->ScrollTargetCenterRatio.x = center_x_ratio; + window->ScrollTargetEdgeSnapDist.x = 0.0f; +} + +void ImGui::SetScrollFromPosY(ImGuiWindow* window, float local_y, float center_y_ratio) +{ + IM_ASSERT(center_y_ratio >= 0.0f && center_y_ratio <= 1.0f); + const float decoration_up_height = window->TitleBarHeight() + window->MenuBarHeight(); // FIXME: Would be nice to have a more standardized access to our scrollable/client rect; + local_y -= decoration_up_height; + window->ScrollTarget.y = IM_FLOOR(local_y + window->Scroll.y); // Convert local position to scroll offset + window->ScrollTargetCenterRatio.y = center_y_ratio; + window->ScrollTargetEdgeSnapDist.y = 0.0f; +} + +void ImGui::SetScrollFromPosX(float local_x, float center_x_ratio) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + SetScrollFromPosX(g.CurrentWindow, local_x, center_x_ratio); +} + +void ImGui::SetScrollFromPosY(float local_y, float center_y_ratio) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + SetScrollFromPosY(g.CurrentWindow, local_y, center_y_ratio); +} + +// center_x_ratio: 0.0f left of last item, 0.5f horizontal center of last item, 1.0f right of last item. +void ImGui::SetScrollHereX(float center_x_ratio) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + float spacing_x = ImMax(window->WindowPadding.x, g.Style.ItemSpacing.x); + float target_pos_x = ImLerp(g.LastItemData.Rect.Min.x - spacing_x, g.LastItemData.Rect.Max.x + spacing_x, center_x_ratio); + SetScrollFromPosX(window, target_pos_x - window->Pos.x, center_x_ratio); // Convert from absolute to local pos + + // Tweak: snap on edges when aiming at an item very close to the edge + window->ScrollTargetEdgeSnapDist.x = ImMax(0.0f, window->WindowPadding.x - spacing_x); +} + +// center_y_ratio: 0.0f top of last item, 0.5f vertical center of last item, 1.0f bottom of last item. +void ImGui::SetScrollHereY(float center_y_ratio) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + float spacing_y = ImMax(window->WindowPadding.y, g.Style.ItemSpacing.y); + float target_pos_y = ImLerp(window->DC.CursorPosPrevLine.y - spacing_y, window->DC.CursorPosPrevLine.y + window->DC.PrevLineSize.y + spacing_y, center_y_ratio); + SetScrollFromPosY(window, target_pos_y - window->Pos.y, center_y_ratio); // Convert from absolute to local pos + + // Tweak: snap on edges when aiming at an item very close to the edge + window->ScrollTargetEdgeSnapDist.y = ImMax(0.0f, window->WindowPadding.y - spacing_y); +} + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] TOOLTIPS +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +void ImGui::BeginTooltip() +{ + BeginTooltipEx(ImGuiWindowFlags_None, ImGuiTooltipFlags_None); +} + +void ImGui::BeginTooltipEx(ImGuiWindowFlags extra_flags, ImGuiTooltipFlags tooltip_flags) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + + if (g.DragDropWithinSource || g.DragDropWithinTarget) + { + // The default tooltip position is a little offset to give space to see the context menu (it's also clamped within the current viewport/monitor) + // In the context of a dragging tooltip we try to reduce that offset and we enforce following the cursor. + // Whatever we do we want to call SetNextWindowPos() to enforce a tooltip position and disable clipping the tooltip without our display area, like regular tooltip do. + //ImVec2 tooltip_pos = g.IO.MousePos - g.ActiveIdClickOffset - g.Style.WindowPadding; + ImVec2 tooltip_pos = g.IO.MousePos + ImVec2(16 * g.Style.MouseCursorScale, 8 * g.Style.MouseCursorScale); + SetNextWindowPos(tooltip_pos); + SetNextWindowBgAlpha(g.Style.Colors[ImGuiCol_PopupBg].w * 0.60f); + //PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_Alpha, g.Style.Alpha * 0.60f); // This would be nice but e.g ColorButton with checkboard has issue with transparent colors :( + tooltip_flags |= ImGuiTooltipFlags_OverridePreviousTooltip; + } + + char window_name[16]; + ImFormatString(window_name, IM_ARRAYSIZE(window_name), "##Tooltip_%02d", g.TooltipOverrideCount); + if (tooltip_flags & ImGuiTooltipFlags_OverridePreviousTooltip) + if (ImGuiWindow* window = FindWindowByName(window_name)) + if (window->Active) + { + // Hide previous tooltip from being displayed. We can't easily "reset" the content of a window so we create a new one. + window->Hidden = true; + window->HiddenFramesCanSkipItems = 1; // FIXME: This may not be necessary? + ImFormatString(window_name, IM_ARRAYSIZE(window_name), "##Tooltip_%02d", ++g.TooltipOverrideCount); + } + ImGuiWindowFlags flags = ImGuiWindowFlags_Tooltip | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoInputs | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoMove | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoResize | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoSavedSettings | ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize; + Begin(window_name, NULL, flags | extra_flags); +} + +void ImGui::EndTooltip() +{ + IM_ASSERT(GetCurrentWindowRead()->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Tooltip); // Mismatched BeginTooltip()/EndTooltip() calls + End(); +} + +void ImGui::SetTooltipV(const char* fmt, va_list args) +{ + BeginTooltipEx(0, ImGuiTooltipFlags_OverridePreviousTooltip); + TextV(fmt, args); + EndTooltip(); +} + +void ImGui::SetTooltip(const char* fmt, ...) +{ + va_list args; + va_start(args, fmt); + SetTooltipV(fmt, args); + va_end(args); +} + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] POPUPS +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// Supported flags: ImGuiPopupFlags_AnyPopupId, ImGuiPopupFlags_AnyPopupLevel +bool ImGui::IsPopupOpen(ImGuiID id, ImGuiPopupFlags popup_flags) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + if (popup_flags & ImGuiPopupFlags_AnyPopupId) + { + // Return true if any popup is open at the current BeginPopup() level of the popup stack + // This may be used to e.g. test for another popups already opened to handle popups priorities at the same level. + IM_ASSERT(id == 0); + if (popup_flags & ImGuiPopupFlags_AnyPopupLevel) + return g.OpenPopupStack.Size > 0; + else + return g.OpenPopupStack.Size > g.BeginPopupStack.Size; + } + else + { + if (popup_flags & ImGuiPopupFlags_AnyPopupLevel) + { + // Return true if the popup is open anywhere in the popup stack + for (int n = 0; n < g.OpenPopupStack.Size; n++) + if (g.OpenPopupStack[n].PopupId == id) + return true; + return false; + } + else + { + // Return true if the popup is open at the current BeginPopup() level of the popup stack (this is the most-common query) + return g.OpenPopupStack.Size > g.BeginPopupStack.Size && g.OpenPopupStack[g.BeginPopupStack.Size].PopupId == id; + } + } +} + +bool ImGui::IsPopupOpen(const char* str_id, ImGuiPopupFlags popup_flags) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiID id = (popup_flags & ImGuiPopupFlags_AnyPopupId) ? 0 : g.CurrentWindow->GetID(str_id); + if ((popup_flags & ImGuiPopupFlags_AnyPopupLevel) && id != 0) + IM_ASSERT(0 && "Cannot use IsPopupOpen() with a string id and ImGuiPopupFlags_AnyPopupLevel."); // But non-string version is legal and used internally + return IsPopupOpen(id, popup_flags); +} + +ImGuiWindow* ImGui::GetTopMostPopupModal() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + for (int n = g.OpenPopupStack.Size - 1; n >= 0; n--) + if (ImGuiWindow* popup = g.OpenPopupStack.Data[n].Window) + if (popup->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Modal) + return popup; + return NULL; +} + +void ImGui::OpenPopup(const char* str_id, ImGuiPopupFlags popup_flags) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + OpenPopupEx(g.CurrentWindow->GetID(str_id), popup_flags); +} + +void ImGui::OpenPopup(ImGuiID id, ImGuiPopupFlags popup_flags) +{ + OpenPopupEx(id, popup_flags); +} + +// Mark popup as open (toggle toward open state). +// Popups are closed when user click outside, or activate a pressable item, or CloseCurrentPopup() is called within a BeginPopup()/EndPopup() block. +// Popup identifiers are relative to the current ID-stack (so OpenPopup and BeginPopup needs to be at the same level). +// One open popup per level of the popup hierarchy (NB: when assigning we reset the Window member of ImGuiPopupRef to NULL) +void ImGui::OpenPopupEx(ImGuiID id, ImGuiPopupFlags popup_flags) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* parent_window = g.CurrentWindow; + const int current_stack_size = g.BeginPopupStack.Size; + + if (popup_flags & ImGuiPopupFlags_NoOpenOverExistingPopup) + if (IsPopupOpen(0u, ImGuiPopupFlags_AnyPopupId)) + return; + + ImGuiPopupData popup_ref; // Tagged as new ref as Window will be set back to NULL if we write this into OpenPopupStack. + popup_ref.PopupId = id; + popup_ref.Window = NULL; + popup_ref.SourceWindow = g.NavWindow; + popup_ref.OpenFrameCount = g.FrameCount; + popup_ref.OpenParentId = parent_window->IDStack.back(); + popup_ref.OpenPopupPos = NavCalcPreferredRefPos(); + popup_ref.OpenMousePos = IsMousePosValid(&g.IO.MousePos) ? g.IO.MousePos : popup_ref.OpenPopupPos; + + IMGUI_DEBUG_LOG_POPUP("OpenPopupEx(0x%08X)\n", id); + if (g.OpenPopupStack.Size < current_stack_size + 1) + { + g.OpenPopupStack.push_back(popup_ref); + } + else + { + // Gently handle the user mistakenly calling OpenPopup() every frame. It is a programming mistake! However, if we were to run the regular code path, the ui + // would become completely unusable because the popup will always be in hidden-while-calculating-size state _while_ claiming focus. Which would be a very confusing + // situation for the programmer. Instead, we silently allow the popup to proceed, it will keep reappearing and the programming error will be more obvious to understand. + if (g.OpenPopupStack[current_stack_size].PopupId == id && g.OpenPopupStack[current_stack_size].OpenFrameCount == g.FrameCount - 1) + { + g.OpenPopupStack[current_stack_size].OpenFrameCount = popup_ref.OpenFrameCount; + } + else + { + // Close child popups if any, then flag popup for open/reopen + ClosePopupToLevel(current_stack_size, false); + g.OpenPopupStack.push_back(popup_ref); + } + + // When reopening a popup we first refocus its parent, otherwise if its parent is itself a popup it would get closed by ClosePopupsOverWindow(). + // This is equivalent to what ClosePopupToLevel() does. + //if (g.OpenPopupStack[current_stack_size].PopupId == id) + // FocusWindow(parent_window); + } +} + +// When popups are stacked, clicking on a lower level popups puts focus back to it and close popups above it. +// This function closes any popups that are over 'ref_window'. +void ImGui::ClosePopupsOverWindow(ImGuiWindow* ref_window, bool restore_focus_to_window_under_popup) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + if (g.OpenPopupStack.Size == 0) + return; + + // Don't close our own child popup windows. + int popup_count_to_keep = 0; + if (ref_window) + { + // Find the highest popup which is a descendant of the reference window (generally reference window = NavWindow) + for (; popup_count_to_keep < g.OpenPopupStack.Size; popup_count_to_keep++) + { + ImGuiPopupData& popup = g.OpenPopupStack[popup_count_to_keep]; + if (!popup.Window) + continue; + IM_ASSERT((popup.Window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup) != 0); + if (popup.Window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow) + continue; + + // Trim the stack unless the popup is a direct parent of the reference window (the reference window is often the NavWindow) + // - With this stack of window, clicking/focusing Popup1 will close Popup2 and Popup3: + // Window -> Popup1 -> Popup2 -> Popup3 + // - Each popups may contain child windows, which is why we compare ->RootWindow! + // Window -> Popup1 -> Popup1_Child -> Popup2 -> Popup2_Child + bool ref_window_is_descendent_of_popup = false; + for (int n = popup_count_to_keep; n < g.OpenPopupStack.Size; n++) + if (ImGuiWindow* popup_window = g.OpenPopupStack[n].Window) + if (popup_window->RootWindow == ref_window->RootWindow) + { + ref_window_is_descendent_of_popup = true; + break; + } + if (!ref_window_is_descendent_of_popup) + break; + } + } + if (popup_count_to_keep < g.OpenPopupStack.Size) // This test is not required but it allows to set a convenient breakpoint on the statement below + { + IMGUI_DEBUG_LOG_POPUP("ClosePopupsOverWindow(\"%s\") -> ClosePopupToLevel(%d)\n", ref_window->Name, popup_count_to_keep); + ClosePopupToLevel(popup_count_to_keep, restore_focus_to_window_under_popup); + } +} + +void ImGui::ClosePopupToLevel(int remaining, bool restore_focus_to_window_under_popup) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + IMGUI_DEBUG_LOG_POPUP("ClosePopupToLevel(%d), restore_focus_to_window_under_popup=%d\n", remaining, restore_focus_to_window_under_popup); + IM_ASSERT(remaining >= 0 && remaining < g.OpenPopupStack.Size); + + // Trim open popup stack + ImGuiWindow* focus_window = g.OpenPopupStack[remaining].SourceWindow; + ImGuiWindow* popup_window = g.OpenPopupStack[remaining].Window; + g.OpenPopupStack.resize(remaining); + + if (restore_focus_to_window_under_popup) + { + if (focus_window && !focus_window->WasActive && popup_window) + { + // Fallback + FocusTopMostWindowUnderOne(popup_window, NULL); + } + else + { + if (g.NavLayer == ImGuiNavLayer_Main && focus_window) + focus_window = NavRestoreLastChildNavWindow(focus_window); + FocusWindow(focus_window); + } + } +} + +// Close the popup we have begin-ed into. +void ImGui::CloseCurrentPopup() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + int popup_idx = g.BeginPopupStack.Size - 1; + if (popup_idx < 0 || popup_idx >= g.OpenPopupStack.Size || g.BeginPopupStack[popup_idx].PopupId != g.OpenPopupStack[popup_idx].PopupId) + return; + + // Closing a menu closes its top-most parent popup (unless a modal) + while (popup_idx > 0) + { + ImGuiWindow* popup_window = g.OpenPopupStack[popup_idx].Window; + ImGuiWindow* parent_popup_window = g.OpenPopupStack[popup_idx - 1].Window; + bool close_parent = false; + if (popup_window && (popup_window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildMenu)) + if (parent_popup_window == NULL || !(parent_popup_window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Modal)) + close_parent = true; + if (!close_parent) + break; + popup_idx--; + } + IMGUI_DEBUG_LOG_POPUP("CloseCurrentPopup %d -> %d\n", g.BeginPopupStack.Size - 1, popup_idx); + ClosePopupToLevel(popup_idx, true); + + // A common pattern is to close a popup when selecting a menu item/selectable that will open another window. + // To improve this usage pattern, we avoid nav highlight for a single frame in the parent window. + // Similarly, we could avoid mouse hover highlight in this window but it is less visually problematic. + if (ImGuiWindow* window = g.NavWindow) + window->DC.NavHideHighlightOneFrame = true; +} + +// Attention! BeginPopup() adds default flags which BeginPopupEx()! +bool ImGui::BeginPopupEx(ImGuiID id, ImGuiWindowFlags flags) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + if (!IsPopupOpen(id, ImGuiPopupFlags_None)) + { + g.NextWindowData.ClearFlags(); // We behave like Begin() and need to consume those values + return false; + } + + char name[20]; + if (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildMenu) + ImFormatString(name, IM_ARRAYSIZE(name), "##Menu_%02d", g.BeginPopupStack.Size); // Recycle windows based on depth + else + ImFormatString(name, IM_ARRAYSIZE(name), "##Popup_%08x", id); // Not recycling, so we can close/open during the same frame + + flags |= ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup; + bool is_open = Begin(name, NULL, flags); + if (!is_open) // NB: Begin can return false when the popup is completely clipped (e.g. zero size display) + EndPopup(); + + return is_open; +} + +bool ImGui::BeginPopup(const char* str_id, ImGuiWindowFlags flags) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + if (g.OpenPopupStack.Size <= g.BeginPopupStack.Size) // Early out for performance + { + g.NextWindowData.ClearFlags(); // We behave like Begin() and need to consume those values + return false; + } + flags |= ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoSavedSettings; + return BeginPopupEx(g.CurrentWindow->GetID(str_id), flags); +} + +// If 'p_open' is specified for a modal popup window, the popup will have a regular close button which will close the popup. +// Note that popup visibility status is owned by Dear ImGui (and manipulated with e.g. OpenPopup) so the actual value of *p_open is meaningless here. +bool ImGui::BeginPopupModal(const char* name, bool* p_open, ImGuiWindowFlags flags) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + const ImGuiID id = window->GetID(name); + if (!IsPopupOpen(id, ImGuiPopupFlags_None)) + { + g.NextWindowData.ClearFlags(); // We behave like Begin() and need to consume those values + return false; + } + + // Center modal windows by default for increased visibility + // (this won't really last as settings will kick in, and is mostly for backward compatibility. user may do the same themselves) + // FIXME: Should test for (PosCond & window->SetWindowPosAllowFlags) with the upcoming window. + if ((g.NextWindowData.Flags & ImGuiNextWindowDataFlags_HasPos) == 0) + { + const ImGuiViewport* viewport = GetMainViewport(); + SetNextWindowPos(viewport->GetCenter(), ImGuiCond_FirstUseEver, ImVec2(0.5f, 0.5f)); + } + + flags |= ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup | ImGuiWindowFlags_Modal | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoCollapse; + const bool is_open = Begin(name, p_open, flags); + if (!is_open || (p_open && !*p_open)) // NB: is_open can be 'false' when the popup is completely clipped (e.g. zero size display) + { + EndPopup(); + if (is_open) + ClosePopupToLevel(g.BeginPopupStack.Size, true); + return false; + } + return is_open; +} + +void ImGui::EndPopup() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + IM_ASSERT(window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup); // Mismatched BeginPopup()/EndPopup() calls + IM_ASSERT(g.BeginPopupStack.Size > 0); + + // Make all menus and popups wrap around for now, may need to expose that policy. + if (g.NavWindow == window) + NavMoveRequestTryWrapping(window, ImGuiNavMoveFlags_LoopY); + + // Child-popups don't need to be laid out + IM_ASSERT(g.WithinEndChild == false); + if (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow) + g.WithinEndChild = true; + End(); + g.WithinEndChild = false; +} + +// Helper to open a popup if mouse button is released over the item +// - This is essentially the same as BeginPopupContextItem() but without the trailing BeginPopup() +void ImGui::OpenPopupOnItemClick(const char* str_id, ImGuiPopupFlags popup_flags) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + int mouse_button = (popup_flags & ImGuiPopupFlags_MouseButtonMask_); + if (IsMouseReleased(mouse_button) && IsItemHovered(ImGuiHoveredFlags_AllowWhenBlockedByPopup)) + { + ImGuiID id = str_id ? window->GetID(str_id) : g.LastItemData.ID; // If user hasn't passed an ID, we can use the LastItemID. Using LastItemID as a Popup ID won't conflict! + IM_ASSERT(id != 0); // You cannot pass a NULL str_id if the last item has no identifier (e.g. a Text() item) + OpenPopupEx(id, popup_flags); + } +} + +// This is a helper to handle the simplest case of associating one named popup to one given widget. +// - To create a popup associated to the last item, you generally want to pass a NULL value to str_id. +// - To create a popup with a specific identifier, pass it in str_id. +// - This is useful when using using BeginPopupContextItem() on an item which doesn't have an identifier, e.g. a Text() call. +// - This is useful when multiple code locations may want to manipulate/open the same popup, given an explicit id. +// - You may want to handle the whole on user side if you have specific needs (e.g. tweaking IsItemHovered() parameters). +// This is essentially the same as: +// id = str_id ? GetID(str_id) : GetItemID(); +// OpenPopupOnItemClick(str_id); +// return BeginPopup(id); +// Which is essentially the same as: +// id = str_id ? GetID(str_id) : GetItemID(); +// if (IsItemHovered() && IsMouseReleased(ImGuiMouseButton_Right)) +// OpenPopup(id); +// return BeginPopup(id); +// The main difference being that this is tweaked to avoid computing the ID twice. +bool ImGui::BeginPopupContextItem(const char* str_id, ImGuiPopupFlags popup_flags) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + if (window->SkipItems) + return false; + ImGuiID id = str_id ? window->GetID(str_id) : g.LastItemData.ID; // If user hasn't passed an ID, we can use the LastItemID. Using LastItemID as a Popup ID won't conflict! + IM_ASSERT(id != 0); // You cannot pass a NULL str_id if the last item has no identifier (e.g. a Text() item) + int mouse_button = (popup_flags & ImGuiPopupFlags_MouseButtonMask_); + if (IsMouseReleased(mouse_button) && IsItemHovered(ImGuiHoveredFlags_AllowWhenBlockedByPopup)) + OpenPopupEx(id, popup_flags); + return BeginPopupEx(id, ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoSavedSettings); +} + +bool ImGui::BeginPopupContextWindow(const char* str_id, ImGuiPopupFlags popup_flags) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + if (!str_id) + str_id = "window_context"; + ImGuiID id = window->GetID(str_id); + int mouse_button = (popup_flags & ImGuiPopupFlags_MouseButtonMask_); + if (IsMouseReleased(mouse_button) && IsWindowHovered(ImGuiHoveredFlags_AllowWhenBlockedByPopup)) + if (!(popup_flags & ImGuiPopupFlags_NoOpenOverItems) || !IsAnyItemHovered()) + OpenPopupEx(id, popup_flags); + return BeginPopupEx(id, ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoSavedSettings); +} + +bool ImGui::BeginPopupContextVoid(const char* str_id, ImGuiPopupFlags popup_flags) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + if (!str_id) + str_id = "void_context"; + ImGuiID id = window->GetID(str_id); + int mouse_button = (popup_flags & ImGuiPopupFlags_MouseButtonMask_); + if (IsMouseReleased(mouse_button) && !IsWindowHovered(ImGuiHoveredFlags_AnyWindow)) + if (GetTopMostPopupModal() == NULL) + OpenPopupEx(id, popup_flags); + return BeginPopupEx(id, ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoSavedSettings); +} + +// r_avoid = the rectangle to avoid (e.g. for tooltip it is a rectangle around the mouse cursor which we want to avoid. for popups it's a small point around the cursor.) +// r_outer = the visible area rectangle, minus safe area padding. If our popup size won't fit because of safe area padding we ignore it. +// (r_outer is usually equivalent to the viewport rectangle minus padding, but when multi-viewports are enabled and monitor +// information are available, it may represent the entire platform monitor from the frame of reference of the current viewport. +// this allows us to have tooltips/popups displayed out of the parent viewport.) +ImVec2 ImGui::FindBestWindowPosForPopupEx(const ImVec2& ref_pos, const ImVec2& size, ImGuiDir* last_dir, const ImRect& r_outer, const ImRect& r_avoid, ImGuiPopupPositionPolicy policy) +{ + ImVec2 base_pos_clamped = ImClamp(ref_pos, r_outer.Min, r_outer.Max - size); + //GetForegroundDrawList()->AddRect(r_avoid.Min, r_avoid.Max, IM_COL32(255,0,0,255)); + //GetForegroundDrawList()->AddRect(r_outer.Min, r_outer.Max, IM_COL32(0,255,0,255)); + + // Combo Box policy (we want a connecting edge) + if (policy == ImGuiPopupPositionPolicy_ComboBox) + { + const ImGuiDir dir_prefered_order[ImGuiDir_COUNT] = { ImGuiDir_Down, ImGuiDir_Right, ImGuiDir_Left, ImGuiDir_Up }; + for (int n = (*last_dir != ImGuiDir_None) ? -1 : 0; n < ImGuiDir_COUNT; n++) + { + const ImGuiDir dir = (n == -1) ? *last_dir : dir_prefered_order[n]; + if (n != -1 && dir == *last_dir) // Already tried this direction? + continue; + ImVec2 pos; + if (dir == ImGuiDir_Down) pos = ImVec2(r_avoid.Min.x, r_avoid.Max.y); // Below, Toward Right (default) + if (dir == ImGuiDir_Right) pos = ImVec2(r_avoid.Min.x, r_avoid.Min.y - size.y); // Above, Toward Right + if (dir == ImGuiDir_Left) pos = ImVec2(r_avoid.Max.x - size.x, r_avoid.Max.y); // Below, Toward Left + if (dir == ImGuiDir_Up) pos = ImVec2(r_avoid.Max.x - size.x, r_avoid.Min.y - size.y); // Above, Toward Left + if (!r_outer.Contains(ImRect(pos, pos + size))) + continue; + *last_dir = dir; + return pos; + } + } + + // Tooltip and Default popup policy + // (Always first try the direction we used on the last frame, if any) + if (policy == ImGuiPopupPositionPolicy_Tooltip || policy == ImGuiPopupPositionPolicy_Default) + { + const ImGuiDir dir_prefered_order[ImGuiDir_COUNT] = { ImGuiDir_Right, ImGuiDir_Down, ImGuiDir_Up, ImGuiDir_Left }; + for (int n = (*last_dir != ImGuiDir_None) ? -1 : 0; n < ImGuiDir_COUNT; n++) + { + const ImGuiDir dir = (n == -1) ? *last_dir : dir_prefered_order[n]; + if (n != -1 && dir == *last_dir) // Already tried this direction? + continue; + + const float avail_w = (dir == ImGuiDir_Left ? r_avoid.Min.x : r_outer.Max.x) - (dir == ImGuiDir_Right ? r_avoid.Max.x : r_outer.Min.x); + const float avail_h = (dir == ImGuiDir_Up ? r_avoid.Min.y : r_outer.Max.y) - (dir == ImGuiDir_Down ? r_avoid.Max.y : r_outer.Min.y); + + // If there not enough room on one axis, there's no point in positioning on a side on this axis (e.g. when not enough width, use a top/bottom position to maximize available width) + if (avail_w < size.x && (dir == ImGuiDir_Left || dir == ImGuiDir_Right)) + continue; + if (avail_h < size.y && (dir == ImGuiDir_Up || dir == ImGuiDir_Down)) + continue; + + ImVec2 pos; + pos.x = (dir == ImGuiDir_Left) ? r_avoid.Min.x - size.x : (dir == ImGuiDir_Right) ? r_avoid.Max.x : base_pos_clamped.x; + pos.y = (dir == ImGuiDir_Up) ? r_avoid.Min.y - size.y : (dir == ImGuiDir_Down) ? r_avoid.Max.y : base_pos_clamped.y; + + // Clamp top-left corner of popup + pos.x = ImMax(pos.x, r_outer.Min.x); + pos.y = ImMax(pos.y, r_outer.Min.y); + + *last_dir = dir; + return pos; + } + } + + // Fallback when not enough room: + *last_dir = ImGuiDir_None; + + // For tooltip we prefer avoiding the cursor at all cost even if it means that part of the tooltip won't be visible. + if (policy == ImGuiPopupPositionPolicy_Tooltip) + return ref_pos + ImVec2(2, 2); + + // Otherwise try to keep within display + ImVec2 pos = ref_pos; + pos.x = ImMax(ImMin(pos.x + size.x, r_outer.Max.x) - size.x, r_outer.Min.x); + pos.y = ImMax(ImMin(pos.y + size.y, r_outer.Max.y) - size.y, r_outer.Min.y); + return pos; +} + +// Note that this is used for popups, which can overlap the non work-area of individual viewports. +ImRect ImGui::GetPopupAllowedExtentRect(ImGuiWindow* window) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + IM_UNUSED(window); + ImRect r_screen = ((ImGuiViewportP*)(void*)GetMainViewport())->GetMainRect(); + ImVec2 padding = g.Style.DisplaySafeAreaPadding; + r_screen.Expand(ImVec2((r_screen.GetWidth() > padding.x * 2) ? -padding.x : 0.0f, (r_screen.GetHeight() > padding.y * 2) ? -padding.y : 0.0f)); + return r_screen; +} + +ImVec2 ImGui::FindBestWindowPosForPopup(ImGuiWindow* window) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + + ImRect r_outer = GetPopupAllowedExtentRect(window); + if (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildMenu) + { + // Child menus typically request _any_ position within the parent menu item, and then we move the new menu outside the parent bounds. + // This is how we end up with child menus appearing (most-commonly) on the right of the parent menu. + IM_ASSERT(g.CurrentWindow == window); + ImGuiWindow* parent_window = g.CurrentWindowStack[g.CurrentWindowStack.Size - 2].Window; + float horizontal_overlap = g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x; // We want some overlap to convey the relative depth of each menu (currently the amount of overlap is hard-coded to style.ItemSpacing.x). + ImRect r_avoid; + if (parent_window->DC.MenuBarAppending) + r_avoid = ImRect(-FLT_MAX, parent_window->ClipRect.Min.y, FLT_MAX, parent_window->ClipRect.Max.y); // Avoid parent menu-bar. If we wanted multi-line menu-bar, we may instead want to have the calling window setup e.g. a NextWindowData.PosConstraintAvoidRect field + else + r_avoid = ImRect(parent_window->Pos.x + horizontal_overlap, -FLT_MAX, parent_window->Pos.x + parent_window->Size.x - horizontal_overlap - parent_window->ScrollbarSizes.x, FLT_MAX); + return FindBestWindowPosForPopupEx(window->Pos, window->Size, &window->AutoPosLastDirection, r_outer, r_avoid, ImGuiPopupPositionPolicy_Default); + } + if (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup) + { + ImRect r_avoid = ImRect(window->Pos.x - 1, window->Pos.y - 1, window->Pos.x + 1, window->Pos.y + 1); + return FindBestWindowPosForPopupEx(window->Pos, window->Size, &window->AutoPosLastDirection, r_outer, r_avoid, ImGuiPopupPositionPolicy_Default); + } + if (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Tooltip) + { + // Position tooltip (always follows mouse) + float sc = g.Style.MouseCursorScale; + ImVec2 ref_pos = NavCalcPreferredRefPos(); + ImRect r_avoid; + if (!g.NavDisableHighlight && g.NavDisableMouseHover && !(g.IO.ConfigFlags & ImGuiConfigFlags_NavEnableSetMousePos)) + r_avoid = ImRect(ref_pos.x - 16, ref_pos.y - 8, ref_pos.x + 16, ref_pos.y + 8); + else + r_avoid = ImRect(ref_pos.x - 16, ref_pos.y - 8, ref_pos.x + 24 * sc, ref_pos.y + 24 * sc); // FIXME: Hard-coded based on mouse cursor shape expectation. Exact dimension not very important. + return FindBestWindowPosForPopupEx(ref_pos, window->Size, &window->AutoPosLastDirection, r_outer, r_avoid, ImGuiPopupPositionPolicy_Tooltip); + } + IM_ASSERT(0); + return window->Pos; +} + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] KEYBOARD/GAMEPAD NAVIGATION +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// FIXME-NAV: The existence of SetNavID vs SetFocusID properly needs to be clarified/reworked. +void ImGui::SetNavID(ImGuiID id, ImGuiNavLayer nav_layer, ImGuiID focus_scope_id, const ImRect& rect_rel) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + IM_ASSERT(g.NavWindow != NULL); + IM_ASSERT(nav_layer == ImGuiNavLayer_Main || nav_layer == ImGuiNavLayer_Menu); + g.NavId = id; + g.NavLayer = nav_layer; + g.NavFocusScopeId = focus_scope_id; + g.NavWindow->NavLastIds[nav_layer] = id; + g.NavWindow->NavRectRel[nav_layer] = rect_rel; + //g.NavDisableHighlight = false; + //g.NavDisableMouseHover = g.NavMousePosDirty = true; +} + +void ImGui::SetFocusID(ImGuiID id, ImGuiWindow* window) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + IM_ASSERT(id != 0); + + // Assume that SetFocusID() is called in the context where its window->DC.NavLayerCurrent and window->DC.NavFocusScopeIdCurrent are valid. + // Note that window may be != g.CurrentWindow (e.g. SetFocusID call in InputTextEx for multi-line text) + const ImGuiNavLayer nav_layer = window->DC.NavLayerCurrent; + if (g.NavWindow != window) + g.NavInitRequest = false; + g.NavWindow = window; + g.NavId = id; + g.NavLayer = nav_layer; + g.NavFocusScopeId = window->DC.NavFocusScopeIdCurrent; + window->NavLastIds[nav_layer] = id; + if (g.LastItemData.ID == id) + window->NavRectRel[nav_layer] = ImRect(g.LastItemData.Rect.Min - window->Pos, g.LastItemData.Rect.Max - window->Pos); + + if (g.ActiveIdSource == ImGuiInputSource_Nav) + g.NavDisableMouseHover = true; + else + g.NavDisableHighlight = true; +} + +ImGuiDir ImGetDirQuadrantFromDelta(float dx, float dy) +{ + if (ImFabs(dx) > ImFabs(dy)) + return (dx > 0.0f) ? ImGuiDir_Right : ImGuiDir_Left; + return (dy > 0.0f) ? ImGuiDir_Down : ImGuiDir_Up; +} + +static float inline NavScoreItemDistInterval(float a0, float a1, float b0, float b1) +{ + if (a1 < b0) + return a1 - b0; + if (b1 < a0) + return a0 - b1; + return 0.0f; +} + +static void inline NavClampRectToVisibleAreaForMoveDir(ImGuiDir move_dir, ImRect& r, const ImRect& clip_rect) +{ + if (move_dir == ImGuiDir_Left || move_dir == ImGuiDir_Right) + { + r.Min.y = ImClamp(r.Min.y, clip_rect.Min.y, clip_rect.Max.y); + r.Max.y = ImClamp(r.Max.y, clip_rect.Min.y, clip_rect.Max.y); + } + else + { + r.Min.x = ImClamp(r.Min.x, clip_rect.Min.x, clip_rect.Max.x); + r.Max.x = ImClamp(r.Max.x, clip_rect.Min.x, clip_rect.Max.x); + } +} + +// Scoring function for gamepad/keyboard directional navigation. Based on https://gist.github.com/rygorous/6981057 +static bool ImGui::NavScoreItem(ImGuiNavItemData* result, ImRect cand) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + if (g.NavLayer != window->DC.NavLayerCurrent) + return false; + + const ImRect& curr = g.NavScoringRect; // Current modified source rect (NB: we've applied Max.x = Min.x in NavUpdate() to inhibit the effect of having varied item width) + g.NavScoringCount++; + + // When entering through a NavFlattened border, we consider child window items as fully clipped for scoring + if (window->ParentWindow == g.NavWindow) + { + IM_ASSERT((window->Flags | g.NavWindow->Flags) & ImGuiWindowFlags_NavFlattened); + if (!window->ClipRect.Overlaps(cand)) + return false; + cand.ClipWithFull(window->ClipRect); // This allows the scored item to not overlap other candidates in the parent window + } + + // We perform scoring on items bounding box clipped by the current clipping rectangle on the other axis (clipping on our movement axis would give us equal scores for all clipped items) + // For example, this ensure that items in one column are not reached when moving vertically from items in another column. + NavClampRectToVisibleAreaForMoveDir(g.NavMoveClipDir, cand, window->ClipRect); + + // Compute distance between boxes + // FIXME-NAV: Introducing biases for vertical navigation, needs to be removed. + float dbx = NavScoreItemDistInterval(cand.Min.x, cand.Max.x, curr.Min.x, curr.Max.x); + float dby = NavScoreItemDistInterval(ImLerp(cand.Min.y, cand.Max.y, 0.2f), ImLerp(cand.Min.y, cand.Max.y, 0.8f), ImLerp(curr.Min.y, curr.Max.y, 0.2f), ImLerp(curr.Min.y, curr.Max.y, 0.8f)); // Scale down on Y to keep using box-distance for vertically touching items + if (dby != 0.0f && dbx != 0.0f) + dbx = (dbx / 1000.0f) + ((dbx > 0.0f) ? +1.0f : -1.0f); + float dist_box = ImFabs(dbx) + ImFabs(dby); + + // Compute distance between centers (this is off by a factor of 2, but we only compare center distances with each other so it doesn't matter) + float dcx = (cand.Min.x + cand.Max.x) - (curr.Min.x + curr.Max.x); + float dcy = (cand.Min.y + cand.Max.y) - (curr.Min.y + curr.Max.y); + float dist_center = ImFabs(dcx) + ImFabs(dcy); // L1 metric (need this for our connectedness guarantee) + + // Determine which quadrant of 'curr' our candidate item 'cand' lies in based on distance + ImGuiDir quadrant; + float dax = 0.0f, day = 0.0f, dist_axial = 0.0f; + if (dbx != 0.0f || dby != 0.0f) + { + // For non-overlapping boxes, use distance between boxes + dax = dbx; + day = dby; + dist_axial = dist_box; + quadrant = ImGetDirQuadrantFromDelta(dbx, dby); + } + else if (dcx != 0.0f || dcy != 0.0f) + { + // For overlapping boxes with different centers, use distance between centers + dax = dcx; + day = dcy; + dist_axial = dist_center; + quadrant = ImGetDirQuadrantFromDelta(dcx, dcy); + } + else + { + // Degenerate case: two overlapping buttons with same center, break ties arbitrarily (note that LastItemId here is really the _previous_ item order, but it doesn't matter) + quadrant = (g.LastItemData.ID < g.NavId) ? ImGuiDir_Left : ImGuiDir_Right; + } + +#if IMGUI_DEBUG_NAV_SCORING + char buf[128]; + if (IsMouseHoveringRect(cand.Min, cand.Max)) + { + ImFormatString(buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf), "dbox (%.2f,%.2f->%.4f)\ndcen (%.2f,%.2f->%.4f)\nd (%.2f,%.2f->%.4f)\nnav %c, quadrant %c", dbx, dby, dist_box, dcx, dcy, dist_center, dax, day, dist_axial, "WENS"[g.NavMoveDir], "WENS"[quadrant]); + ImDrawList* draw_list = GetForegroundDrawList(window); + draw_list->AddRect(curr.Min, curr.Max, IM_COL32(255,200,0,100)); + draw_list->AddRect(cand.Min, cand.Max, IM_COL32(255,255,0,200)); + draw_list->AddRectFilled(cand.Max - ImVec2(4, 4), cand.Max + CalcTextSize(buf) + ImVec2(4, 4), IM_COL32(40,0,0,150)); + draw_list->AddText(g.IO.FontDefault, 13.0f, cand.Max, ~0U, buf); + } + else if (g.IO.KeyCtrl) // Hold to preview score in matching quadrant. Press C to rotate. + { + if (IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_C)) { g.NavMoveDirLast = (ImGuiDir)((g.NavMoveDirLast + 1) & 3); g.IO.KeysDownDuration[g.IO.KeyMap[ImGuiKey_C]] = 0.01f; } + if (quadrant == g.NavMoveDir) + { + ImFormatString(buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf), "%.0f/%.0f", dist_box, dist_center); + ImDrawList* draw_list = GetForegroundDrawList(window); + draw_list->AddRectFilled(cand.Min, cand.Max, IM_COL32(255, 0, 0, 200)); + draw_list->AddText(g.IO.FontDefault, 13.0f, cand.Min, IM_COL32(255, 255, 255, 255), buf); + } + } +#endif + + // Is it in the quadrant we're interesting in moving to? + bool new_best = false; + if (quadrant == g.NavMoveDir) + { + // Does it beat the current best candidate? + if (dist_box < result->DistBox) + { + result->DistBox = dist_box; + result->DistCenter = dist_center; + return true; + } + if (dist_box == result->DistBox) + { + // Try using distance between center points to break ties + if (dist_center < result->DistCenter) + { + result->DistCenter = dist_center; + new_best = true; + } + else if (dist_center == result->DistCenter) + { + // Still tied! we need to be extra-careful to make sure everything gets linked properly. We consistently break ties by symbolically moving "later" items + // (with higher index) to the right/downwards by an infinitesimal amount since we the current "best" button already (so it must have a lower index), + // this is fairly easy. This rule ensures that all buttons with dx==dy==0 will end up being linked in order of appearance along the x axis. + if (((g.NavMoveDir == ImGuiDir_Up || g.NavMoveDir == ImGuiDir_Down) ? dby : dbx) < 0.0f) // moving bj to the right/down decreases distance + new_best = true; + } + } + } + + // Axial check: if 'curr' has no link at all in some direction and 'cand' lies roughly in that direction, add a tentative link. This will only be kept if no "real" matches + // are found, so it only augments the graph produced by the above method using extra links. (important, since it doesn't guarantee strong connectedness) + // This is just to avoid buttons having no links in a particular direction when there's a suitable neighbor. you get good graphs without this too. + // 2017/09/29: FIXME: This now currently only enabled inside menu bars, ideally we'd disable it everywhere. Menus in particular need to catch failure. For general navigation it feels awkward. + // Disabling it may lead to disconnected graphs when nodes are very spaced out on different axis. Perhaps consider offering this as an option? + if (result->DistBox == FLT_MAX && dist_axial < result->DistAxial) // Check axial match + if (g.NavLayer == ImGuiNavLayer_Menu && !(g.NavWindow->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildMenu)) + if ((g.NavMoveDir == ImGuiDir_Left && dax < 0.0f) || (g.NavMoveDir == ImGuiDir_Right && dax > 0.0f) || (g.NavMoveDir == ImGuiDir_Up && day < 0.0f) || (g.NavMoveDir == ImGuiDir_Down && day > 0.0f)) + { + result->DistAxial = dist_axial; + new_best = true; + } + + return new_best; +} + +static void ImGui::NavApplyItemToResult(ImGuiNavItemData* result, ImGuiWindow* window, ImGuiID id, const ImRect& nav_bb_rel) +{ + result->Window = window; + result->ID = id; + result->FocusScopeId = window->DC.NavFocusScopeIdCurrent; + result->RectRel = nav_bb_rel; +} + +// We get there when either NavId == id, or when g.NavAnyRequest is set (which is updated by NavUpdateAnyRequestFlag above) +static void ImGui::NavProcessItem(ImGuiWindow* window, const ImRect& nav_bb, const ImGuiID id) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + //if (!g.IO.NavActive) // [2017/10/06] Removed this possibly redundant test but I am not sure of all the side-effects yet. Some of the feature here will need to work regardless of using a _NoNavInputs flag. + // return; + + const ImGuiItemFlags item_flags = g.LastItemData.InFlags; + const ImRect nav_bb_rel(nav_bb.Min - window->Pos, nav_bb.Max - window->Pos); + + // Process Init Request + if (g.NavInitRequest && g.NavLayer == window->DC.NavLayerCurrent) + { + // Even if 'ImGuiItemFlags_NoNavDefaultFocus' is on (typically collapse/close button) we record the first ResultId so they can be used as a fallback + const bool candidate_for_nav_default_focus = (item_flags & (ImGuiItemFlags_NoNavDefaultFocus | ImGuiItemFlags_Disabled)) == 0; + if (candidate_for_nav_default_focus || g.NavInitResultId == 0) + { + g.NavInitResultId = id; + g.NavInitResultRectRel = nav_bb_rel; + } + if (candidate_for_nav_default_focus) + { + g.NavInitRequest = false; // Found a match, clear request + NavUpdateAnyRequestFlag(); + } + } + + // Process Move Request (scoring for navigation) + // FIXME-NAV: Consider policy for double scoring (scoring from NavScoringRectScreen + scoring from a rect wrapped according to current wrapping policy) + if ((g.NavId != id || (g.NavMoveRequestFlags & ImGuiNavMoveFlags_AllowCurrentNavId)) && !(item_flags & (ImGuiItemFlags_Disabled | ImGuiItemFlags_NoNav))) + { + ImGuiNavItemData* result = (window == g.NavWindow) ? &g.NavMoveResultLocal : &g.NavMoveResultOther; +#if IMGUI_DEBUG_NAV_SCORING + // [DEBUG] Score all items in NavWindow at all times + if (!g.NavMoveRequest) + g.NavMoveDir = g.NavMoveDirLast; + bool new_best = NavScoreItem(result, nav_bb) && g.NavMoveRequest; +#else + bool new_best = g.NavMoveRequest && NavScoreItem(result, nav_bb); +#endif + if (new_best) + NavApplyItemToResult(result, window, id, nav_bb_rel); + + // Features like PageUp/PageDown need to maintain a separate score for the visible set of items. + const float VISIBLE_RATIO = 0.70f; + if ((g.NavMoveRequestFlags & ImGuiNavMoveFlags_AlsoScoreVisibleSet) && window->ClipRect.Overlaps(nav_bb)) + if (ImClamp(nav_bb.Max.y, window->ClipRect.Min.y, window->ClipRect.Max.y) - ImClamp(nav_bb.Min.y, window->ClipRect.Min.y, window->ClipRect.Max.y) >= (nav_bb.Max.y - nav_bb.Min.y) * VISIBLE_RATIO) + if (NavScoreItem(&g.NavMoveResultLocalVisibleSet, nav_bb)) + NavApplyItemToResult(&g.NavMoveResultLocalVisibleSet, window, id, nav_bb_rel); + } + + // Update window-relative bounding box of navigated item + if (g.NavId == id) + { + g.NavWindow = window; // Always refresh g.NavWindow, because some operations such as FocusItem() don't have a window. + g.NavLayer = window->DC.NavLayerCurrent; + g.NavFocusScopeId = window->DC.NavFocusScopeIdCurrent; + g.NavIdIsAlive = true; + window->NavRectRel[window->DC.NavLayerCurrent] = nav_bb_rel; // Store item bounding box (relative to window position) + } +} + +bool ImGui::NavMoveRequestButNoResultYet() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + return g.NavMoveRequest && g.NavMoveResultLocal.ID == 0 && g.NavMoveResultOther.ID == 0; +} + +void ImGui::NavMoveRequestCancel() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + g.NavMoveRequest = false; + NavUpdateAnyRequestFlag(); +} + +void ImGui::NavMoveRequestForward(ImGuiDir move_dir, ImGuiDir clip_dir, const ImRect& bb_rel, ImGuiNavMoveFlags move_flags) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + IM_ASSERT(g.NavMoveRequestForward == ImGuiNavForward_None); + NavMoveRequestCancel(); + g.NavMoveDir = move_dir; + g.NavMoveClipDir = clip_dir; + g.NavMoveRequestForward = ImGuiNavForward_ForwardQueued; + g.NavMoveRequestFlags = move_flags; + g.NavWindow->NavRectRel[g.NavLayer] = bb_rel; +} + +void ImGui::NavMoveRequestTryWrapping(ImGuiWindow* window, ImGuiNavMoveFlags move_flags) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + + // Navigation wrap-around logic is delayed to the end of the frame because this operation is only valid after entire + // popup is assembled and in case of appended popups it is not clear which EndPopup() call is final. + g.NavWrapRequestWindow = window; + g.NavWrapRequestFlags = move_flags; +} + +// FIXME: This could be replaced by updating a frame number in each window when (window == NavWindow) and (NavLayer == 0). +// This way we could find the last focused window among our children. It would be much less confusing this way? +static void ImGui::NavSaveLastChildNavWindowIntoParent(ImGuiWindow* nav_window) +{ + ImGuiWindow* parent = nav_window; + while (parent && parent->RootWindow != parent && (parent->Flags & (ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup | ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildMenu)) == 0) + parent = parent->ParentWindow; + if (parent && parent != nav_window) + parent->NavLastChildNavWindow = nav_window; +} + +// Restore the last focused child. +// Call when we are expected to land on the Main Layer (0) after FocusWindow() +static ImGuiWindow* ImGui::NavRestoreLastChildNavWindow(ImGuiWindow* window) +{ + if (window->NavLastChildNavWindow && window->NavLastChildNavWindow->WasActive) + return window->NavLastChildNavWindow; + return window; +} + +void ImGui::NavRestoreLayer(ImGuiNavLayer layer) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + if (layer == ImGuiNavLayer_Main) + g.NavWindow = NavRestoreLastChildNavWindow(g.NavWindow); + ImGuiWindow* window = g.NavWindow; + if (window->NavLastIds[layer] != 0) + { + SetNavID(window->NavLastIds[layer], layer, 0, window->NavRectRel[layer]); + g.NavDisableHighlight = false; + g.NavDisableMouseHover = g.NavMousePosDirty = true; + } + else + { + g.NavLayer = layer; + NavInitWindow(window, true); + } +} + +static inline void ImGui::NavUpdateAnyRequestFlag() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + g.NavAnyRequest = g.NavMoveRequest || g.NavInitRequest || (IMGUI_DEBUG_NAV_SCORING && g.NavWindow != NULL); + if (g.NavAnyRequest) + IM_ASSERT(g.NavWindow != NULL); +} + +// This needs to be called before we submit any widget (aka in or before Begin) +void ImGui::NavInitWindow(ImGuiWindow* window, bool force_reinit) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + IM_ASSERT(window == g.NavWindow); + + if (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoNavInputs) + { + g.NavId = g.NavFocusScopeId = 0; + return; + } + + bool init_for_nav = false; + if (window == window->RootWindow || (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup) || (window->NavLastIds[0] == 0) || force_reinit) + init_for_nav = true; + IMGUI_DEBUG_LOG_NAV("[nav] NavInitRequest: from NavInitWindow(), init_for_nav=%d, window=\"%s\", layer=%d\n", init_for_nav, window->Name, g.NavLayer); + if (init_for_nav) + { + SetNavID(0, g.NavLayer, 0, ImRect()); + g.NavInitRequest = true; + g.NavInitRequestFromMove = false; + g.NavInitResultId = 0; + g.NavInitResultRectRel = ImRect(); + NavUpdateAnyRequestFlag(); + } + else + { + g.NavId = window->NavLastIds[0]; + g.NavFocusScopeId = 0; + } +} + +static ImVec2 ImGui::NavCalcPreferredRefPos() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + if (g.NavDisableHighlight || !g.NavDisableMouseHover || !g.NavWindow) + { + // Mouse (we need a fallback in case the mouse becomes invalid after being used) + if (IsMousePosValid(&g.IO.MousePos)) + return g.IO.MousePos; + return g.LastValidMousePos; + } + else + { + // When navigation is active and mouse is disabled, decide on an arbitrary position around the bottom left of the currently navigated item. + const ImRect& rect_rel = g.NavWindow->NavRectRel[g.NavLayer]; + ImVec2 pos = g.NavWindow->Pos + ImVec2(rect_rel.Min.x + ImMin(g.Style.FramePadding.x * 4, rect_rel.GetWidth()), rect_rel.Max.y - ImMin(g.Style.FramePadding.y, rect_rel.GetHeight())); + ImGuiViewport* viewport = GetMainViewport(); + return ImFloor(ImClamp(pos, viewport->Pos, viewport->Pos + viewport->Size)); // ImFloor() is important because non-integer mouse position application in backend might be lossy and result in undesirable non-zero delta. + } +} + +float ImGui::GetNavInputAmount(ImGuiNavInput n, ImGuiInputReadMode mode) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + if (mode == ImGuiInputReadMode_Down) + return g.IO.NavInputs[n]; // Instant, read analog input (0.0f..1.0f, as provided by user) + + const float t = g.IO.NavInputsDownDuration[n]; + if (t < 0.0f && mode == ImGuiInputReadMode_Released) // Return 1.0f when just released, no repeat, ignore analog input. + return (g.IO.NavInputsDownDurationPrev[n] >= 0.0f ? 1.0f : 0.0f); + if (t < 0.0f) + return 0.0f; + if (mode == ImGuiInputReadMode_Pressed) // Return 1.0f when just pressed, no repeat, ignore analog input. + return (t == 0.0f) ? 1.0f : 0.0f; + if (mode == ImGuiInputReadMode_Repeat) + return (float)CalcTypematicRepeatAmount(t - g.IO.DeltaTime, t, g.IO.KeyRepeatDelay * 0.72f, g.IO.KeyRepeatRate * 0.80f); + if (mode == ImGuiInputReadMode_RepeatSlow) + return (float)CalcTypematicRepeatAmount(t - g.IO.DeltaTime, t, g.IO.KeyRepeatDelay * 1.25f, g.IO.KeyRepeatRate * 2.00f); + if (mode == ImGuiInputReadMode_RepeatFast) + return (float)CalcTypematicRepeatAmount(t - g.IO.DeltaTime, t, g.IO.KeyRepeatDelay * 0.72f, g.IO.KeyRepeatRate * 0.30f); + return 0.0f; +} + +ImVec2 ImGui::GetNavInputAmount2d(ImGuiNavDirSourceFlags dir_sources, ImGuiInputReadMode mode, float slow_factor, float fast_factor) +{ + ImVec2 delta(0.0f, 0.0f); + if (dir_sources & ImGuiNavDirSourceFlags_Keyboard) + delta += ImVec2(GetNavInputAmount(ImGuiNavInput_KeyRight_, mode) - GetNavInputAmount(ImGuiNavInput_KeyLeft_, mode), GetNavInputAmount(ImGuiNavInput_KeyDown_, mode) - GetNavInputAmount(ImGuiNavInput_KeyUp_, mode)); + if (dir_sources & ImGuiNavDirSourceFlags_PadDPad) + delta += ImVec2(GetNavInputAmount(ImGuiNavInput_DpadRight, mode) - GetNavInputAmount(ImGuiNavInput_DpadLeft, mode), GetNavInputAmount(ImGuiNavInput_DpadDown, mode) - GetNavInputAmount(ImGuiNavInput_DpadUp, mode)); + if (dir_sources & ImGuiNavDirSourceFlags_PadLStick) + delta += ImVec2(GetNavInputAmount(ImGuiNavInput_LStickRight, mode) - GetNavInputAmount(ImGuiNavInput_LStickLeft, mode), GetNavInputAmount(ImGuiNavInput_LStickDown, mode) - GetNavInputAmount(ImGuiNavInput_LStickUp, mode)); + if (slow_factor != 0.0f && IsNavInputDown(ImGuiNavInput_TweakSlow)) + delta *= slow_factor; + if (fast_factor != 0.0f && IsNavInputDown(ImGuiNavInput_TweakFast)) + delta *= fast_factor; + return delta; +} + +static void ImGui::NavUpdate() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiIO& io = g.IO; + + io.WantSetMousePos = false; + g.NavWrapRequestWindow = NULL; + g.NavWrapRequestFlags = ImGuiNavMoveFlags_None; +#if 0 + if (g.NavScoringCount > 0) IMGUI_DEBUG_LOG("NavScoringCount %d for '%s' layer %d (Init:%d, Move:%d)\n", g.FrameCount, g.NavScoringCount, g.NavWindow ? g.NavWindow->Name : "NULL", g.NavLayer, g.NavInitRequest || g.NavInitResultId != 0, g.NavMoveRequest); +#endif + + // Set input source as Gamepad when buttons are pressed (as some features differs when used with Gamepad vs Keyboard) + // (do it before we map Keyboard input!) + bool nav_keyboard_active = (io.ConfigFlags & ImGuiConfigFlags_NavEnableKeyboard) != 0; + bool nav_gamepad_active = (io.ConfigFlags & ImGuiConfigFlags_NavEnableGamepad) != 0 && (io.BackendFlags & ImGuiBackendFlags_HasGamepad) != 0; + if (nav_gamepad_active && g.NavInputSource != ImGuiInputSource_Gamepad) + { + if (io.NavInputs[ImGuiNavInput_Activate] > 0.0f || io.NavInputs[ImGuiNavInput_Input] > 0.0f || io.NavInputs[ImGuiNavInput_Cancel] > 0.0f || io.NavInputs[ImGuiNavInput_Menu] > 0.0f + || io.NavInputs[ImGuiNavInput_DpadLeft] > 0.0f || io.NavInputs[ImGuiNavInput_DpadRight] > 0.0f || io.NavInputs[ImGuiNavInput_DpadUp] > 0.0f || io.NavInputs[ImGuiNavInput_DpadDown] > 0.0f) + g.NavInputSource = ImGuiInputSource_Gamepad; + } + + // Update Keyboard->Nav inputs mapping + if (nav_keyboard_active) + { + #define NAV_MAP_KEY(_KEY, _NAV_INPUT) do { if (IsKeyDown(io.KeyMap[_KEY])) { io.NavInputs[_NAV_INPUT] = 1.0f; g.NavInputSource = ImGuiInputSource_Keyboard; } } while (0) + NAV_MAP_KEY(ImGuiKey_Space, ImGuiNavInput_Activate ); + NAV_MAP_KEY(ImGuiKey_Enter, ImGuiNavInput_Input ); + NAV_MAP_KEY(ImGuiKey_Escape, ImGuiNavInput_Cancel ); + NAV_MAP_KEY(ImGuiKey_LeftArrow, ImGuiNavInput_KeyLeft_ ); + NAV_MAP_KEY(ImGuiKey_RightArrow,ImGuiNavInput_KeyRight_); + NAV_MAP_KEY(ImGuiKey_UpArrow, ImGuiNavInput_KeyUp_ ); + NAV_MAP_KEY(ImGuiKey_DownArrow, ImGuiNavInput_KeyDown_ ); + if (io.KeyCtrl) + io.NavInputs[ImGuiNavInput_TweakSlow] = 1.0f; + if (io.KeyShift) + io.NavInputs[ImGuiNavInput_TweakFast] = 1.0f; + #undef NAV_MAP_KEY + } + memcpy(io.NavInputsDownDurationPrev, io.NavInputsDownDuration, sizeof(io.NavInputsDownDuration)); + for (int i = 0; i < IM_ARRAYSIZE(io.NavInputs); i++) + io.NavInputsDownDuration[i] = (io.NavInputs[i] > 0.0f) ? (io.NavInputsDownDuration[i] < 0.0f ? 0.0f : io.NavInputsDownDuration[i] + io.DeltaTime) : -1.0f; + + // Process navigation init request (select first/default focus) + if (g.NavInitResultId != 0) + NavUpdateInitResult(); + g.NavInitRequest = false; + g.NavInitRequestFromMove = false; + g.NavInitResultId = 0; + g.NavJustMovedToId = 0; + + // Process navigation move request + if (g.NavMoveRequest) + NavUpdateMoveResult(); + + // When a forwarded move request failed, we restore the highlight that we disabled during the forward frame + if (g.NavMoveRequestForward == ImGuiNavForward_ForwardActive) + { + IM_ASSERT(g.NavMoveRequest); + if (g.NavMoveResultLocal.ID == 0 && g.NavMoveResultOther.ID == 0) + g.NavDisableHighlight = false; + g.NavMoveRequestForward = ImGuiNavForward_None; + } + + // Apply application mouse position movement, after we had a chance to process move request result. + if (g.NavMousePosDirty && g.NavIdIsAlive) + { + // Set mouse position given our knowledge of the navigated item position from last frame + if ((io.ConfigFlags & ImGuiConfigFlags_NavEnableSetMousePos) && (io.BackendFlags & ImGuiBackendFlags_HasSetMousePos)) + if (!g.NavDisableHighlight && g.NavDisableMouseHover && g.NavWindow) + { + io.MousePos = io.MousePosPrev = NavCalcPreferredRefPos(); + io.WantSetMousePos = true; + } + g.NavMousePosDirty = false; + } + g.NavIdIsAlive = false; + g.NavJustTabbedId = 0; + IM_ASSERT(g.NavLayer == 0 || g.NavLayer == 1); + + // Store our return window (for returning from Layer 1 to Layer 0) and clear it as soon as we step back in our own Layer 0 + if (g.NavWindow) + NavSaveLastChildNavWindowIntoParent(g.NavWindow); + if (g.NavWindow && g.NavWindow->NavLastChildNavWindow != NULL && g.NavLayer == ImGuiNavLayer_Main) + g.NavWindow->NavLastChildNavWindow = NULL; + + // Update CTRL+TAB and Windowing features (hold Square to move/resize/etc.) + NavUpdateWindowing(); + + // Set output flags for user application + io.NavActive = (nav_keyboard_active || nav_gamepad_active) && g.NavWindow && !(g.NavWindow->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoNavInputs); + io.NavVisible = (io.NavActive && g.NavId != 0 && !g.NavDisableHighlight) || (g.NavWindowingTarget != NULL); + + // Process NavCancel input (to close a popup, get back to parent, clear focus) + if (IsNavInputTest(ImGuiNavInput_Cancel, ImGuiInputReadMode_Pressed)) + { + IMGUI_DEBUG_LOG_NAV("[nav] ImGuiNavInput_Cancel\n"); + if (g.ActiveId != 0) + { + if (!IsActiveIdUsingNavInput(ImGuiNavInput_Cancel)) + ClearActiveID(); + } + else if (g.NavLayer != ImGuiNavLayer_Main) + { + // Leave the "menu" layer + NavRestoreLayer(ImGuiNavLayer_Main); + } + else if (g.NavWindow && g.NavWindow != g.NavWindow->RootWindow && !(g.NavWindow->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup) && g.NavWindow->ParentWindow) + { + // Exit child window + ImGuiWindow* child_window = g.NavWindow; + ImGuiWindow* parent_window = g.NavWindow->ParentWindow; + IM_ASSERT(child_window->ChildId != 0); + ImRect child_rect = child_window->Rect(); + FocusWindow(parent_window); + SetNavID(child_window->ChildId, ImGuiNavLayer_Main, 0, ImRect(child_rect.Min - parent_window->Pos, child_rect.Max - parent_window->Pos)); + } + else if (g.OpenPopupStack.Size > 0) + { + // Close open popup/menu + if (!(g.OpenPopupStack.back().Window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Modal)) + ClosePopupToLevel(g.OpenPopupStack.Size - 1, true); + } + else + { + // Clear NavLastId for popups but keep it for regular child window so we can leave one and come back where we were + if (g.NavWindow && ((g.NavWindow->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup) || !(g.NavWindow->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow))) + g.NavWindow->NavLastIds[0] = 0; + g.NavId = g.NavFocusScopeId = 0; + } + } + + // Process manual activation request + g.NavActivateId = g.NavActivateDownId = g.NavActivatePressedId = g.NavInputId = 0; + if (g.NavId != 0 && !g.NavDisableHighlight && !g.NavWindowingTarget && g.NavWindow && !(g.NavWindow->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoNavInputs)) + { + bool activate_down = IsNavInputDown(ImGuiNavInput_Activate); + bool activate_pressed = activate_down && IsNavInputTest(ImGuiNavInput_Activate, ImGuiInputReadMode_Pressed); + if (g.ActiveId == 0 && activate_pressed) + g.NavActivateId = g.NavId; + if ((g.ActiveId == 0 || g.ActiveId == g.NavId) && activate_down) + g.NavActivateDownId = g.NavId; + if ((g.ActiveId == 0 || g.ActiveId == g.NavId) && activate_pressed) + g.NavActivatePressedId = g.NavId; + if ((g.ActiveId == 0 || g.ActiveId == g.NavId) && IsNavInputTest(ImGuiNavInput_Input, ImGuiInputReadMode_Pressed)) + g.NavInputId = g.NavId; + } + if (g.NavWindow && (g.NavWindow->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoNavInputs)) + g.NavDisableHighlight = true; + if (g.NavActivateId != 0) + IM_ASSERT(g.NavActivateDownId == g.NavActivateId); + g.NavMoveRequest = false; + + // Process programmatic activation request + if (g.NavNextActivateId != 0) + g.NavActivateId = g.NavActivateDownId = g.NavActivatePressedId = g.NavInputId = g.NavNextActivateId; + g.NavNextActivateId = 0; + + // Initiate directional inputs request + if (g.NavMoveRequestForward == ImGuiNavForward_None) + { + g.NavMoveDir = ImGuiDir_None; + g.NavMoveRequestFlags = ImGuiNavMoveFlags_None; + if (g.NavWindow && !g.NavWindowingTarget && !(g.NavWindow->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoNavInputs)) + { + const ImGuiInputReadMode read_mode = ImGuiInputReadMode_Repeat; + if (!IsActiveIdUsingNavDir(ImGuiDir_Left) && (IsNavInputTest(ImGuiNavInput_DpadLeft, read_mode) || IsNavInputTest(ImGuiNavInput_KeyLeft_, read_mode))) { g.NavMoveDir = ImGuiDir_Left; } + if (!IsActiveIdUsingNavDir(ImGuiDir_Right) && (IsNavInputTest(ImGuiNavInput_DpadRight, read_mode) || IsNavInputTest(ImGuiNavInput_KeyRight_, read_mode))) { g.NavMoveDir = ImGuiDir_Right; } + if (!IsActiveIdUsingNavDir(ImGuiDir_Up) && (IsNavInputTest(ImGuiNavInput_DpadUp, read_mode) || IsNavInputTest(ImGuiNavInput_KeyUp_, read_mode))) { g.NavMoveDir = ImGuiDir_Up; } + if (!IsActiveIdUsingNavDir(ImGuiDir_Down) && (IsNavInputTest(ImGuiNavInput_DpadDown, read_mode) || IsNavInputTest(ImGuiNavInput_KeyDown_, read_mode))) { g.NavMoveDir = ImGuiDir_Down; } + } + g.NavMoveClipDir = g.NavMoveDir; + } + else + { + // Forwarding previous request (which has been modified, e.g. wrap around menus rewrite the requests with a starting rectangle at the other side of the window) + // (Preserve g.NavMoveRequestFlags, g.NavMoveClipDir which were set by the NavMoveRequestForward() function) + IM_ASSERT(g.NavMoveDir != ImGuiDir_None && g.NavMoveClipDir != ImGuiDir_None); + IM_ASSERT(g.NavMoveRequestForward == ImGuiNavForward_ForwardQueued); + IMGUI_DEBUG_LOG_NAV("[nav] NavMoveRequestForward %d\n", g.NavMoveDir); + g.NavMoveRequestForward = ImGuiNavForward_ForwardActive; + } + + // Update PageUp/PageDown/Home/End scroll + // FIXME-NAV: Consider enabling those keys even without the master ImGuiConfigFlags_NavEnableKeyboard flag? + float nav_scoring_rect_offset_y = 0.0f; + if (nav_keyboard_active) + nav_scoring_rect_offset_y = NavUpdatePageUpPageDown(); + + // If we initiate a movement request and have no current NavId, we initiate a InitDefautRequest that will be used as a fallback if the direction fails to find a match + if (g.NavMoveDir != ImGuiDir_None) + { + g.NavMoveRequest = true; + g.NavMoveRequestKeyMods = io.KeyMods; + g.NavMoveDirLast = g.NavMoveDir; + } + if (g.NavMoveRequest && g.NavId == 0) + { + IMGUI_DEBUG_LOG_NAV("[nav] NavInitRequest: from move, window \"%s\", layer=%d\n", g.NavWindow->Name, g.NavLayer); + g.NavInitRequest = g.NavInitRequestFromMove = true; + // Reassigning with same value, we're being explicit here. + g.NavInitResultId = 0; // -V1048 + g.NavDisableHighlight = false; + } + NavUpdateAnyRequestFlag(); + + // Scrolling + if (g.NavWindow && !(g.NavWindow->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoNavInputs) && !g.NavWindowingTarget) + { + // *Fallback* manual-scroll with Nav directional keys when window has no navigable item + ImGuiWindow* window = g.NavWindow; + const float scroll_speed = IM_ROUND(window->CalcFontSize() * 100 * io.DeltaTime); // We need round the scrolling speed because sub-pixel scroll isn't reliably supported. + if (window->DC.NavLayersActiveMask == 0x00 && window->DC.NavHasScroll && g.NavMoveRequest) + { + if (g.NavMoveDir == ImGuiDir_Left || g.NavMoveDir == ImGuiDir_Right) + SetScrollX(window, ImFloor(window->Scroll.x + ((g.NavMoveDir == ImGuiDir_Left) ? -1.0f : +1.0f) * scroll_speed)); + if (g.NavMoveDir == ImGuiDir_Up || g.NavMoveDir == ImGuiDir_Down) + SetScrollY(window, ImFloor(window->Scroll.y + ((g.NavMoveDir == ImGuiDir_Up) ? -1.0f : +1.0f) * scroll_speed)); + } + + // *Normal* Manual scroll with NavScrollXXX keys + // Next movement request will clamp the NavId reference rectangle to the visible area, so navigation will resume within those bounds. + ImVec2 scroll_dir = GetNavInputAmount2d(ImGuiNavDirSourceFlags_PadLStick, ImGuiInputReadMode_Down, 1.0f / 10.0f, 10.0f); + if (scroll_dir.x != 0.0f && window->ScrollbarX) + SetScrollX(window, ImFloor(window->Scroll.x + scroll_dir.x * scroll_speed)); + if (scroll_dir.y != 0.0f) + SetScrollY(window, ImFloor(window->Scroll.y + scroll_dir.y * scroll_speed)); + } + + // Reset search results + g.NavMoveResultLocal.Clear(); + g.NavMoveResultLocalVisibleSet.Clear(); + g.NavMoveResultOther.Clear(); + + // When using gamepad, we project the reference nav bounding box into window visible area. + // This is to allow resuming navigation inside the visible area after doing a large amount of scrolling, since with gamepad every movements are relative + // (can't focus a visible object like we can with the mouse). + if (g.NavMoveRequest && g.NavInputSource == ImGuiInputSource_Gamepad && g.NavLayer == ImGuiNavLayer_Main) + { + ImGuiWindow* window = g.NavWindow; + ImRect window_rect_rel(window->InnerRect.Min - window->Pos - ImVec2(1, 1), window->InnerRect.Max - window->Pos + ImVec2(1, 1)); + if (!window_rect_rel.Contains(window->NavRectRel[g.NavLayer])) + { + IMGUI_DEBUG_LOG_NAV("[nav] NavMoveRequest: clamp NavRectRel\n"); + float pad = window->CalcFontSize() * 0.5f; + window_rect_rel.Expand(ImVec2(-ImMin(window_rect_rel.GetWidth(), pad), -ImMin(window_rect_rel.GetHeight(), pad))); // Terrible approximation for the intent of starting navigation from first fully visible item + window->NavRectRel[g.NavLayer].ClipWithFull(window_rect_rel); + g.NavId = g.NavFocusScopeId = 0; + } + } + + // For scoring we use a single segment on the left side our current item bounding box (not touching the edge to avoid box overlap with zero-spaced items) + ImRect nav_rect_rel = g.NavWindow && !g.NavWindow->NavRectRel[g.NavLayer].IsInverted() ? g.NavWindow->NavRectRel[g.NavLayer] : ImRect(0, 0, 0, 0); + g.NavScoringRect = g.NavWindow ? ImRect(g.NavWindow->Pos + nav_rect_rel.Min, g.NavWindow->Pos + nav_rect_rel.Max) : ImRect(0, 0, 0, 0); + g.NavScoringRect.TranslateY(nav_scoring_rect_offset_y); + g.NavScoringRect.Min.x = ImMin(g.NavScoringRect.Min.x + 1.0f, g.NavScoringRect.Max.x); + g.NavScoringRect.Max.x = g.NavScoringRect.Min.x; + IM_ASSERT(!g.NavScoringRect.IsInverted()); // Ensure if we have a finite, non-inverted bounding box here will allows us to remove extraneous ImFabs() calls in NavScoreItem(). + //GetForegroundDrawList()->AddRect(g.NavScoringRectScreen.Min, g.NavScoringRectScreen.Max, IM_COL32(255,200,0,255)); // [DEBUG] + g.NavScoringCount = 0; +#if IMGUI_DEBUG_NAV_RECTS + if (g.NavWindow) + { + ImDrawList* draw_list = GetForegroundDrawList(g.NavWindow); + if (1) { for (int layer = 0; layer < 2; layer++) draw_list->AddRect(g.NavWindow->Pos + g.NavWindow->NavRectRel[layer].Min, g.NavWindow->Pos + g.NavWindow->NavRectRel[layer].Max, IM_COL32(255,200,0,255)); } // [DEBUG] + if (1) { ImU32 col = (!g.NavWindow->Hidden) ? IM_COL32(255,0,255,255) : IM_COL32(255,0,0,255); ImVec2 p = NavCalcPreferredRefPos(); char buf[32]; ImFormatString(buf, 32, "%d", g.NavLayer); draw_list->AddCircleFilled(p, 3.0f, col); draw_list->AddText(NULL, 13.0f, p + ImVec2(8,-4), col, buf); } + } +#endif +} + +static void ImGui::NavUpdateInitResult() +{ + // In very rare cases g.NavWindow may be null (e.g. clearing focus after requesting an init request, which does happen when releasing Alt while clicking on void) + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + if (!g.NavWindow) + return; + + // Apply result from previous navigation init request (will typically select the first item, unless SetItemDefaultFocus() has been called) + // FIXME-NAV: On _NavFlattened windows, g.NavWindow will only be updated during subsequent frame. Not a problem currently. + IMGUI_DEBUG_LOG_NAV("[nav] NavInitRequest: result NavID 0x%08X in Layer %d Window \"%s\"\n", g.NavInitResultId, g.NavLayer, g.NavWindow->Name); + SetNavID(g.NavInitResultId, g.NavLayer, 0, g.NavInitResultRectRel); + if (g.NavInitRequestFromMove) + { + g.NavDisableHighlight = false; + g.NavDisableMouseHover = g.NavMousePosDirty = true; + } +} + +// Apply result from previous frame navigation directional move request +static void ImGui::NavUpdateMoveResult() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + if (g.NavMoveResultLocal.ID == 0 && g.NavMoveResultOther.ID == 0) + { + // In a situation when there is no results but NavId != 0, re-enable the Navigation highlight (because g.NavId is not considered as a possible result) + if (g.NavId != 0) + { + g.NavDisableHighlight = false; + g.NavDisableMouseHover = true; + } + return; + } + + // Select which result to use + ImGuiNavItemData* result = (g.NavMoveResultLocal.ID != 0) ? &g.NavMoveResultLocal : &g.NavMoveResultOther; + + // PageUp/PageDown behavior first jumps to the bottom/top mostly visible item, _otherwise_ use the result from the previous/next page. + if (g.NavMoveRequestFlags & ImGuiNavMoveFlags_AlsoScoreVisibleSet) + if (g.NavMoveResultLocalVisibleSet.ID != 0 && g.NavMoveResultLocalVisibleSet.ID != g.NavId) + result = &g.NavMoveResultLocalVisibleSet; + + // Maybe entering a flattened child from the outside? In this case solve the tie using the regular scoring rules. + if (result != &g.NavMoveResultOther && g.NavMoveResultOther.ID != 0 && g.NavMoveResultOther.Window->ParentWindow == g.NavWindow) + if ((g.NavMoveResultOther.DistBox < result->DistBox) || (g.NavMoveResultOther.DistBox == result->DistBox && g.NavMoveResultOther.DistCenter < result->DistCenter)) + result = &g.NavMoveResultOther; + IM_ASSERT(g.NavWindow && result->Window); + + // Scroll to keep newly navigated item fully into view. + if (g.NavLayer == ImGuiNavLayer_Main) + { + ImVec2 delta_scroll; + if (g.NavMoveRequestFlags & ImGuiNavMoveFlags_ScrollToEdge) + { + float scroll_target = (g.NavMoveDir == ImGuiDir_Up) ? result->Window->ScrollMax.y : 0.0f; + delta_scroll.y = result->Window->Scroll.y - scroll_target; + SetScrollY(result->Window, scroll_target); + } + else + { + ImRect rect_abs = ImRect(result->RectRel.Min + result->Window->Pos, result->RectRel.Max + result->Window->Pos); + delta_scroll = ScrollToBringRectIntoView(result->Window, rect_abs); + } + + // Offset our result position so mouse position can be applied immediately after in NavUpdate() + result->RectRel.TranslateX(-delta_scroll.x); + result->RectRel.TranslateY(-delta_scroll.y); + } + + ClearActiveID(); + g.NavWindow = result->Window; + if (g.NavId != result->ID) + { + // Don't set NavJustMovedToId if just landed on the same spot (which may happen with ImGuiNavMoveFlags_AllowCurrentNavId) + g.NavJustMovedToId = result->ID; + g.NavJustMovedToFocusScopeId = result->FocusScopeId; + g.NavJustMovedToKeyMods = g.NavMoveRequestKeyMods; + } + IMGUI_DEBUG_LOG_NAV("[nav] NavMoveRequest: result NavID 0x%08X in Layer %d Window \"%s\"\n", result->ID, g.NavLayer, g.NavWindow->Name); + SetNavID(result->ID, g.NavLayer, result->FocusScopeId, result->RectRel); + g.NavDisableHighlight = false; + g.NavDisableMouseHover = g.NavMousePosDirty = true; +} + +// Handle PageUp/PageDown/Home/End keys +static float ImGui::NavUpdatePageUpPageDown() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiIO& io = g.IO; + + if (g.NavMoveDir != ImGuiDir_None || g.NavWindow == NULL) + return 0.0f; + if ((g.NavWindow->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoNavInputs) || g.NavWindowingTarget != NULL || g.NavLayer != ImGuiNavLayer_Main) + return 0.0f; + + ImGuiWindow* window = g.NavWindow; + const bool page_up_held = IsKeyDown(io.KeyMap[ImGuiKey_PageUp]) && !IsActiveIdUsingKey(ImGuiKey_PageUp); + const bool page_down_held = IsKeyDown(io.KeyMap[ImGuiKey_PageDown]) && !IsActiveIdUsingKey(ImGuiKey_PageDown); + const bool home_pressed = IsKeyPressed(io.KeyMap[ImGuiKey_Home]) && !IsActiveIdUsingKey(ImGuiKey_Home); + const bool end_pressed = IsKeyPressed(io.KeyMap[ImGuiKey_End]) && !IsActiveIdUsingKey(ImGuiKey_End); + if (page_up_held != page_down_held || home_pressed != end_pressed) // If either (not both) are pressed + { + if (window->DC.NavLayersActiveMask == 0x00 && window->DC.NavHasScroll) + { + // Fallback manual-scroll when window has no navigable item + if (IsKeyPressed(io.KeyMap[ImGuiKey_PageUp], true)) + SetScrollY(window, window->Scroll.y - window->InnerRect.GetHeight()); + else if (IsKeyPressed(io.KeyMap[ImGuiKey_PageDown], true)) + SetScrollY(window, window->Scroll.y + window->InnerRect.GetHeight()); + else if (home_pressed) + SetScrollY(window, 0.0f); + else if (end_pressed) + SetScrollY(window, window->ScrollMax.y); + } + else + { + ImRect& nav_rect_rel = window->NavRectRel[g.NavLayer]; + const float page_offset_y = ImMax(0.0f, window->InnerRect.GetHeight() - window->CalcFontSize() * 1.0f + nav_rect_rel.GetHeight()); + float nav_scoring_rect_offset_y = 0.0f; + if (IsKeyPressed(io.KeyMap[ImGuiKey_PageUp], true)) + { + nav_scoring_rect_offset_y = -page_offset_y; + g.NavMoveDir = ImGuiDir_Down; // Because our scoring rect is offset up, we request the down direction (so we can always land on the last item) + g.NavMoveClipDir = ImGuiDir_Up; + g.NavMoveRequestFlags = ImGuiNavMoveFlags_AllowCurrentNavId | ImGuiNavMoveFlags_AlsoScoreVisibleSet; + } + else if (IsKeyPressed(io.KeyMap[ImGuiKey_PageDown], true)) + { + nav_scoring_rect_offset_y = +page_offset_y; + g.NavMoveDir = ImGuiDir_Up; // Because our scoring rect is offset down, we request the up direction (so we can always land on the last item) + g.NavMoveClipDir = ImGuiDir_Down; + g.NavMoveRequestFlags = ImGuiNavMoveFlags_AllowCurrentNavId | ImGuiNavMoveFlags_AlsoScoreVisibleSet; + } + else if (home_pressed) + { + // FIXME-NAV: handling of Home/End is assuming that the top/bottom most item will be visible with Scroll.y == 0/ScrollMax.y + // Scrolling will be handled via the ImGuiNavMoveFlags_ScrollToEdge flag, we don't scroll immediately to avoid scrolling happening before nav result. + // Preserve current horizontal position if we have any. + nav_rect_rel.Min.y = nav_rect_rel.Max.y = -window->Scroll.y; + if (nav_rect_rel.IsInverted()) + nav_rect_rel.Min.x = nav_rect_rel.Max.x = 0.0f; + g.NavMoveDir = ImGuiDir_Down; + g.NavMoveRequestFlags = ImGuiNavMoveFlags_AllowCurrentNavId | ImGuiNavMoveFlags_ScrollToEdge; + } + else if (end_pressed) + { + nav_rect_rel.Min.y = nav_rect_rel.Max.y = window->ScrollMax.y + window->SizeFull.y - window->Scroll.y; + if (nav_rect_rel.IsInverted()) + nav_rect_rel.Min.x = nav_rect_rel.Max.x = 0.0f; + g.NavMoveDir = ImGuiDir_Up; + g.NavMoveRequestFlags = ImGuiNavMoveFlags_AllowCurrentNavId | ImGuiNavMoveFlags_ScrollToEdge; + } + return nav_scoring_rect_offset_y; + } + } + return 0.0f; +} + +static void ImGui::NavEndFrame() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + + // Show CTRL+TAB list window + if (g.NavWindowingTarget != NULL) + NavUpdateWindowingOverlay(); + + // Perform wrap-around in menus + ImGuiWindow* window = g.NavWrapRequestWindow; + ImGuiNavMoveFlags move_flags = g.NavWrapRequestFlags; + if (window != NULL && g.NavWindow == window && NavMoveRequestButNoResultYet() && g.NavMoveRequestForward == ImGuiNavForward_None && g.NavLayer == ImGuiNavLayer_Main) + { + IM_ASSERT(move_flags != 0); // No points calling this with no wrapping + ImRect bb_rel = window->NavRectRel[0]; + + ImGuiDir clip_dir = g.NavMoveDir; + if (g.NavMoveDir == ImGuiDir_Left && (move_flags & (ImGuiNavMoveFlags_WrapX | ImGuiNavMoveFlags_LoopX))) + { + bb_rel.Min.x = bb_rel.Max.x = + ImMax(window->SizeFull.x, window->ContentSize.x + window->WindowPadding.x * 2.0f) - window->Scroll.x; + if (move_flags & ImGuiNavMoveFlags_WrapX) + { + bb_rel.TranslateY(-bb_rel.GetHeight()); + clip_dir = ImGuiDir_Up; + } + NavMoveRequestForward(g.NavMoveDir, clip_dir, bb_rel, move_flags); + } + if (g.NavMoveDir == ImGuiDir_Right && (move_flags & (ImGuiNavMoveFlags_WrapX | ImGuiNavMoveFlags_LoopX))) + { + bb_rel.Min.x = bb_rel.Max.x = -window->Scroll.x; + if (move_flags & ImGuiNavMoveFlags_WrapX) + { + bb_rel.TranslateY(+bb_rel.GetHeight()); + clip_dir = ImGuiDir_Down; + } + NavMoveRequestForward(g.NavMoveDir, clip_dir, bb_rel, move_flags); + } + if (g.NavMoveDir == ImGuiDir_Up && (move_flags & (ImGuiNavMoveFlags_WrapY | ImGuiNavMoveFlags_LoopY))) + { + bb_rel.Min.y = bb_rel.Max.y = + ImMax(window->SizeFull.y, window->ContentSize.y + window->WindowPadding.y * 2.0f) - window->Scroll.y; + if (move_flags & ImGuiNavMoveFlags_WrapY) + { + bb_rel.TranslateX(-bb_rel.GetWidth()); + clip_dir = ImGuiDir_Left; + } + NavMoveRequestForward(g.NavMoveDir, clip_dir, bb_rel, move_flags); + } + if (g.NavMoveDir == ImGuiDir_Down && (move_flags & (ImGuiNavMoveFlags_WrapY | ImGuiNavMoveFlags_LoopY))) + { + bb_rel.Min.y = bb_rel.Max.y = -window->Scroll.y; + if (move_flags & ImGuiNavMoveFlags_WrapY) + { + bb_rel.TranslateX(+bb_rel.GetWidth()); + clip_dir = ImGuiDir_Right; + } + NavMoveRequestForward(g.NavMoveDir, clip_dir, bb_rel, move_flags); + } + } +} + +static int ImGui::FindWindowFocusIndex(ImGuiWindow* window) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + IM_UNUSED(g); + int order = window->FocusOrder; + IM_ASSERT(g.WindowsFocusOrder[order] == window); + return order; +} + +static ImGuiWindow* FindWindowNavFocusable(int i_start, int i_stop, int dir) // FIXME-OPT O(N) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + for (int i = i_start; i >= 0 && i < g.WindowsFocusOrder.Size && i != i_stop; i += dir) + if (ImGui::IsWindowNavFocusable(g.WindowsFocusOrder[i])) + return g.WindowsFocusOrder[i]; + return NULL; +} + +static void NavUpdateWindowingHighlightWindow(int focus_change_dir) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + IM_ASSERT(g.NavWindowingTarget); + if (g.NavWindowingTarget->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Modal) + return; + + const int i_current = ImGui::FindWindowFocusIndex(g.NavWindowingTarget); + ImGuiWindow* window_target = FindWindowNavFocusable(i_current + focus_change_dir, -INT_MAX, focus_change_dir); + if (!window_target) + window_target = FindWindowNavFocusable((focus_change_dir < 0) ? (g.WindowsFocusOrder.Size - 1) : 0, i_current, focus_change_dir); + if (window_target) // Don't reset windowing target if there's a single window in the list + g.NavWindowingTarget = g.NavWindowingTargetAnim = window_target; + g.NavWindowingToggleLayer = false; +} + +// Windowing management mode +// Keyboard: CTRL+Tab (change focus/move/resize), Alt (toggle menu layer) +// Gamepad: Hold Menu/Square (change focus/move/resize), Tap Menu/Square (toggle menu layer) +static void ImGui::NavUpdateWindowing() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiIO& io = g.IO; + + ImGuiWindow* apply_focus_window = NULL; + bool apply_toggle_layer = false; + + ImGuiWindow* modal_window = GetTopMostPopupModal(); + bool allow_windowing = (modal_window == NULL); + if (!allow_windowing) + g.NavWindowingTarget = NULL; + + // Fade out + if (g.NavWindowingTargetAnim && g.NavWindowingTarget == NULL) + { + g.NavWindowingHighlightAlpha = ImMax(g.NavWindowingHighlightAlpha - io.DeltaTime * 10.0f, 0.0f); + if (g.DimBgRatio <= 0.0f && g.NavWindowingHighlightAlpha <= 0.0f) + g.NavWindowingTargetAnim = NULL; + } + + // Start CTRL-TAB or Square+L/R window selection + bool start_windowing_with_gamepad = allow_windowing && !g.NavWindowingTarget && IsNavInputTest(ImGuiNavInput_Menu, ImGuiInputReadMode_Pressed); + bool start_windowing_with_keyboard = allow_windowing && !g.NavWindowingTarget && io.KeyCtrl && IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_Tab) && (io.ConfigFlags & ImGuiConfigFlags_NavEnableKeyboard); + if (start_windowing_with_gamepad || start_windowing_with_keyboard) + if (ImGuiWindow* window = g.NavWindow ? g.NavWindow : FindWindowNavFocusable(g.WindowsFocusOrder.Size - 1, -INT_MAX, -1)) + { + g.NavWindowingTarget = g.NavWindowingTargetAnim = window->RootWindow; + g.NavWindowingTimer = g.NavWindowingHighlightAlpha = 0.0f; + g.NavWindowingToggleLayer = start_windowing_with_gamepad ? true : false; // Gamepad starts toggling layer + g.NavInputSource = start_windowing_with_keyboard ? ImGuiInputSource_Keyboard : ImGuiInputSource_Gamepad; + } + + // Gamepad update + g.NavWindowingTimer += io.DeltaTime; + if (g.NavWindowingTarget && g.NavInputSource == ImGuiInputSource_Gamepad) + { + // Highlight only appears after a brief time holding the button, so that a fast tap on PadMenu (to toggle NavLayer) doesn't add visual noise + g.NavWindowingHighlightAlpha = ImMax(g.NavWindowingHighlightAlpha, ImSaturate((g.NavWindowingTimer - NAV_WINDOWING_HIGHLIGHT_DELAY) / 0.05f)); + + // Select window to focus + const int focus_change_dir = (int)IsNavInputTest(ImGuiNavInput_FocusPrev, ImGuiInputReadMode_RepeatSlow) - (int)IsNavInputTest(ImGuiNavInput_FocusNext, ImGuiInputReadMode_RepeatSlow); + if (focus_change_dir != 0) + { + NavUpdateWindowingHighlightWindow(focus_change_dir); + g.NavWindowingHighlightAlpha = 1.0f; + } + + // Single press toggles NavLayer, long press with L/R apply actual focus on release (until then the window was merely rendered top-most) + if (!IsNavInputDown(ImGuiNavInput_Menu)) + { + g.NavWindowingToggleLayer &= (g.NavWindowingHighlightAlpha < 1.0f); // Once button was held long enough we don't consider it a tap-to-toggle-layer press anymore. + if (g.NavWindowingToggleLayer && g.NavWindow) + apply_toggle_layer = true; + else if (!g.NavWindowingToggleLayer) + apply_focus_window = g.NavWindowingTarget; + g.NavWindowingTarget = NULL; + } + } + + // Keyboard: Focus + if (g.NavWindowingTarget && g.NavInputSource == ImGuiInputSource_Keyboard) + { + // Visuals only appears after a brief time after pressing TAB the first time, so that a fast CTRL+TAB doesn't add visual noise + g.NavWindowingHighlightAlpha = ImMax(g.NavWindowingHighlightAlpha, ImSaturate((g.NavWindowingTimer - NAV_WINDOWING_HIGHLIGHT_DELAY) / 0.05f)); // 1.0f + if (IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_Tab, true)) + NavUpdateWindowingHighlightWindow(io.KeyShift ? +1 : -1); + if (!io.KeyCtrl) + apply_focus_window = g.NavWindowingTarget; + } + + // Keyboard: Press and Release ALT to toggle menu layer + // - Testing that only Alt is tested prevents Alt+Shift or AltGR from toggling menu layer. + // - AltGR is normally Alt+Ctrl but we can't reliably detect it (not all backends/systems/layout emit it as Alt+Ctrl). But even on keyboards without AltGR we don't want Alt+Ctrl to open menu anyway. + if (io.KeyMods == ImGuiKeyModFlags_Alt && (io.KeyModsPrev & ImGuiKeyModFlags_Alt) == 0) + { + g.NavWindowingToggleLayer = true; + g.NavInputSource = ImGuiInputSource_Keyboard; + } + if (g.NavWindowingToggleLayer && g.NavInputSource == ImGuiInputSource_Keyboard) + { + // We cancel toggling nav layer when any text has been typed (generally while holding Alt). (See #370) + // We cancel toggling nav layer when other modifiers are pressed. (See #4439) + if (io.InputQueueCharacters.Size > 0 || io.KeyCtrl || io.KeyShift || io.KeySuper) + g.NavWindowingToggleLayer = false; + + // Apply layer toggle on release + // Important: we don't assume that Alt was previously held in order to handle loss of focus when backend calls io.AddFocusEvent(false) + // Important: as before version <18314 we lacked an explicit IO event for focus gain/loss, we also compare mouse validity to detect old backends clearing mouse pos on focus loss. + if (!(io.KeyMods & ImGuiKeyModFlags_Alt) && (io.KeyModsPrev & ImGuiKeyModFlags_Alt) && g.NavWindowingToggleLayer) + if (g.ActiveId == 0 || g.ActiveIdAllowOverlap) + if (IsMousePosValid(&io.MousePos) == IsMousePosValid(&io.MousePosPrev)) + apply_toggle_layer = true; + if (!io.KeyAlt) + g.NavWindowingToggleLayer = false; + } + + // Move window + if (g.NavWindowingTarget && !(g.NavWindowingTarget->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoMove)) + { + ImVec2 move_delta; + if (g.NavInputSource == ImGuiInputSource_Keyboard && !io.KeyShift) + move_delta = GetNavInputAmount2d(ImGuiNavDirSourceFlags_Keyboard, ImGuiInputReadMode_Down); + if (g.NavInputSource == ImGuiInputSource_Gamepad) + move_delta = GetNavInputAmount2d(ImGuiNavDirSourceFlags_PadLStick, ImGuiInputReadMode_Down); + if (move_delta.x != 0.0f || move_delta.y != 0.0f) + { + const float NAV_MOVE_SPEED = 800.0f; + const float move_speed = ImFloor(NAV_MOVE_SPEED * io.DeltaTime * ImMin(io.DisplayFramebufferScale.x, io.DisplayFramebufferScale.y)); // FIXME: Doesn't handle variable framerate very well + ImGuiWindow* moving_window = g.NavWindowingTarget->RootWindow; + SetWindowPos(moving_window, moving_window->Pos + move_delta * move_speed, ImGuiCond_Always); + MarkIniSettingsDirty(moving_window); + g.NavDisableMouseHover = true; + } + } + + // Apply final focus + if (apply_focus_window && (g.NavWindow == NULL || apply_focus_window != g.NavWindow->RootWindow)) + { + ClearActiveID(); + g.NavDisableHighlight = false; + g.NavDisableMouseHover = true; + apply_focus_window = NavRestoreLastChildNavWindow(apply_focus_window); + ClosePopupsOverWindow(apply_focus_window, false); + FocusWindow(apply_focus_window); + if (apply_focus_window->NavLastIds[0] == 0) + NavInitWindow(apply_focus_window, false); + + // If the window has ONLY a menu layer (no main layer), select it directly + // Use NavLayersActiveMaskNext since windows didn't have a chance to be Begin()-ed on this frame, + // so CTRL+Tab where the keys are only held for 1 frame will be able to use correct layers mask since + // the target window as already been previewed once. + // FIXME-NAV: This should be done in NavInit.. or in FocusWindow... However in both of those cases, + // we won't have a guarantee that windows has been visible before and therefore NavLayersActiveMask* + // won't be valid. + if (apply_focus_window->DC.NavLayersActiveMaskNext == (1 << ImGuiNavLayer_Menu)) + g.NavLayer = ImGuiNavLayer_Menu; + } + if (apply_focus_window) + g.NavWindowingTarget = NULL; + + // Apply menu/layer toggle + if (apply_toggle_layer && g.NavWindow) + { + ClearActiveID(); + + // Move to parent menu if necessary + ImGuiWindow* new_nav_window = g.NavWindow; + while (new_nav_window->ParentWindow + && (new_nav_window->DC.NavLayersActiveMask & (1 << ImGuiNavLayer_Menu)) == 0 + && (new_nav_window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow) != 0 + && (new_nav_window->Flags & (ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup | ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildMenu)) == 0) + new_nav_window = new_nav_window->ParentWindow; + if (new_nav_window != g.NavWindow) + { + ImGuiWindow* old_nav_window = g.NavWindow; + FocusWindow(new_nav_window); + new_nav_window->NavLastChildNavWindow = old_nav_window; + } + g.NavDisableHighlight = false; + g.NavDisableMouseHover = true; + + // Reinitialize navigation when entering menu bar with the Alt key. + const ImGuiNavLayer new_nav_layer = (g.NavWindow->DC.NavLayersActiveMask & (1 << ImGuiNavLayer_Menu)) ? (ImGuiNavLayer)((int)g.NavLayer ^ 1) : ImGuiNavLayer_Main; + if (new_nav_layer == ImGuiNavLayer_Menu) + g.NavWindow->NavLastIds[new_nav_layer] = 0; + NavRestoreLayer(new_nav_layer); + } +} + +// Window has already passed the IsWindowNavFocusable() +static const char* GetFallbackWindowNameForWindowingList(ImGuiWindow* window) +{ + if (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup) + return "(Popup)"; + if ((window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_MenuBar) && strcmp(window->Name, "##MainMenuBar") == 0) + return "(Main menu bar)"; + return "(Untitled)"; +} + +// Overlay displayed when using CTRL+TAB. Called by EndFrame(). +void ImGui::NavUpdateWindowingOverlay() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + IM_ASSERT(g.NavWindowingTarget != NULL); + + if (g.NavWindowingTimer < NAV_WINDOWING_LIST_APPEAR_DELAY) + return; + + if (g.NavWindowingListWindow == NULL) + g.NavWindowingListWindow = FindWindowByName("###NavWindowingList"); + const ImGuiViewport* viewport = GetMainViewport(); + SetNextWindowSizeConstraints(ImVec2(viewport->Size.x * 0.20f, viewport->Size.y * 0.20f), ImVec2(FLT_MAX, FLT_MAX)); + SetNextWindowPos(viewport->GetCenter(), ImGuiCond_Always, ImVec2(0.5f, 0.5f)); + PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_WindowPadding, g.Style.WindowPadding * 2.0f); + Begin("###NavWindowingList", NULL, ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoFocusOnAppearing | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoResize | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoMove | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoInputs | ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoSavedSettings); + for (int n = g.WindowsFocusOrder.Size - 1; n >= 0; n--) + { + ImGuiWindow* window = g.WindowsFocusOrder[n]; + IM_ASSERT(window != NULL); // Fix static analyzers + if (!IsWindowNavFocusable(window)) + continue; + const char* label = window->Name; + if (label == FindRenderedTextEnd(label)) + label = GetFallbackWindowNameForWindowingList(window); + Selectable(label, g.NavWindowingTarget == window); + } + End(); + PopStyleVar(); +} + + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] DRAG AND DROP +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +void ImGui::ClearDragDrop() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + g.DragDropActive = false; + g.DragDropPayload.Clear(); + g.DragDropAcceptFlags = ImGuiDragDropFlags_None; + g.DragDropAcceptIdCurr = g.DragDropAcceptIdPrev = 0; + g.DragDropAcceptIdCurrRectSurface = FLT_MAX; + g.DragDropAcceptFrameCount = -1; + + g.DragDropPayloadBufHeap.clear(); + memset(&g.DragDropPayloadBufLocal, 0, sizeof(g.DragDropPayloadBufLocal)); +} + +// When this returns true you need to: a) call SetDragDropPayload() exactly once, b) you may render the payload visual/description, c) call EndDragDropSource() +// If the item has an identifier: +// - This assume/require the item to be activated (typically via ButtonBehavior). +// - Therefore if you want to use this with a mouse button other than left mouse button, it is up to the item itself to activate with another button. +// - We then pull and use the mouse button that was used to activate the item and use it to carry on the drag. +// If the item has no identifier: +// - Currently always assume left mouse button. +bool ImGui::BeginDragDropSource(ImGuiDragDropFlags flags) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + + // FIXME-DRAGDROP: While in the common-most "drag from non-zero active id" case we can tell the mouse button, + // in both SourceExtern and id==0 cases we may requires something else (explicit flags or some heuristic). + ImGuiMouseButton mouse_button = ImGuiMouseButton_Left; + + bool source_drag_active = false; + ImGuiID source_id = 0; + ImGuiID source_parent_id = 0; + if (!(flags & ImGuiDragDropFlags_SourceExtern)) + { + source_id = g.LastItemData.ID; + if (source_id != 0) + { + // Common path: items with ID + if (g.ActiveId != source_id) + return false; + if (g.ActiveIdMouseButton != -1) + mouse_button = g.ActiveIdMouseButton; + if (g.IO.MouseDown[mouse_button] == false) + return false; + g.ActiveIdAllowOverlap = false; + } + else + { + // Uncommon path: items without ID + if (g.IO.MouseDown[mouse_button] == false) + return false; + + // If you want to use BeginDragDropSource() on an item with no unique identifier for interaction, such as Text() or Image(), you need to: + // A) Read the explanation below, B) Use the ImGuiDragDropFlags_SourceAllowNullID flag, C) Swallow your programmer pride. + if (!(flags & ImGuiDragDropFlags_SourceAllowNullID)) + { + IM_ASSERT(0); + return false; + } + + // Early out + if ((g.LastItemData.StatusFlags & ImGuiItemStatusFlags_HoveredRect) == 0 && (g.ActiveId == 0 || g.ActiveIdWindow != window)) + return false; + + // Magic fallback (=somehow reprehensible) to handle items with no assigned ID, e.g. Text(), Image() + // We build a throwaway ID based on current ID stack + relative AABB of items in window. + // THE IDENTIFIER WON'T SURVIVE ANY REPOSITIONING OF THE WIDGET, so if your widget moves your dragging operation will be canceled. + // We don't need to maintain/call ClearActiveID() as releasing the button will early out this function and trigger !ActiveIdIsAlive. + // Rely on keeping other window->LastItemXXX fields intact. + source_id = g.LastItemData.ID = window->GetIDFromRectangle(g.LastItemData.Rect); + bool is_hovered = ItemHoverable(g.LastItemData.Rect, source_id); + if (is_hovered && g.IO.MouseClicked[mouse_button]) + { + SetActiveID(source_id, window); + FocusWindow(window); + } + if (g.ActiveId == source_id) // Allow the underlying widget to display/return hovered during the mouse release frame, else we would get a flicker. + g.ActiveIdAllowOverlap = is_hovered; + } + if (g.ActiveId != source_id) + return false; + source_parent_id = window->IDStack.back(); + source_drag_active = IsMouseDragging(mouse_button); + + // Disable navigation and key inputs while dragging + cancel existing request if any + SetActiveIdUsingNavAndKeys(); + } + else + { + window = NULL; + source_id = ImHashStr("#SourceExtern"); + source_drag_active = true; + } + + if (source_drag_active) + { + if (!g.DragDropActive) + { + IM_ASSERT(source_id != 0); + ClearDragDrop(); + ImGuiPayload& payload = g.DragDropPayload; + payload.SourceId = source_id; + payload.SourceParentId = source_parent_id; + g.DragDropActive = true; + g.DragDropSourceFlags = flags; + g.DragDropMouseButton = mouse_button; + if (payload.SourceId == g.ActiveId) + g.ActiveIdNoClearOnFocusLoss = true; + } + g.DragDropSourceFrameCount = g.FrameCount; + g.DragDropWithinSource = true; + + if (!(flags & ImGuiDragDropFlags_SourceNoPreviewTooltip)) + { + // Target can request the Source to not display its tooltip (we use a dedicated flag to make this request explicit) + // We unfortunately can't just modify the source flags and skip the call to BeginTooltip, as caller may be emitting contents. + BeginTooltip(); + if (g.DragDropAcceptIdPrev && (g.DragDropAcceptFlags & ImGuiDragDropFlags_AcceptNoPreviewTooltip)) + { + ImGuiWindow* tooltip_window = g.CurrentWindow; + tooltip_window->Hidden = tooltip_window->SkipItems = true; + tooltip_window->HiddenFramesCanSkipItems = 1; + } + } + + if (!(flags & ImGuiDragDropFlags_SourceNoDisableHover) && !(flags & ImGuiDragDropFlags_SourceExtern)) + g.LastItemData.StatusFlags &= ~ImGuiItemStatusFlags_HoveredRect; + + return true; + } + return false; +} + +void ImGui::EndDragDropSource() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + IM_ASSERT(g.DragDropActive); + IM_ASSERT(g.DragDropWithinSource && "Not after a BeginDragDropSource()?"); + + if (!(g.DragDropSourceFlags & ImGuiDragDropFlags_SourceNoPreviewTooltip)) + EndTooltip(); + + // Discard the drag if have not called SetDragDropPayload() + if (g.DragDropPayload.DataFrameCount == -1) + ClearDragDrop(); + g.DragDropWithinSource = false; +} + +// Use 'cond' to choose to submit payload on drag start or every frame +bool ImGui::SetDragDropPayload(const char* type, const void* data, size_t data_size, ImGuiCond cond) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiPayload& payload = g.DragDropPayload; + if (cond == 0) + cond = ImGuiCond_Always; + + IM_ASSERT(type != NULL); + IM_ASSERT(strlen(type) < IM_ARRAYSIZE(payload.DataType) && "Payload type can be at most 32 characters long"); + IM_ASSERT((data != NULL && data_size > 0) || (data == NULL && data_size == 0)); + IM_ASSERT(cond == ImGuiCond_Always || cond == ImGuiCond_Once); + IM_ASSERT(payload.SourceId != 0); // Not called between BeginDragDropSource() and EndDragDropSource() + + if (cond == ImGuiCond_Always || payload.DataFrameCount == -1) + { + // Copy payload + ImStrncpy(payload.DataType, type, IM_ARRAYSIZE(payload.DataType)); + g.DragDropPayloadBufHeap.resize(0); + if (data_size > sizeof(g.DragDropPayloadBufLocal)) + { + // Store in heap + g.DragDropPayloadBufHeap.resize((int)data_size); + payload.Data = g.DragDropPayloadBufHeap.Data; + memcpy(payload.Data, data, data_size); + } + else if (data_size > 0) + { + // Store locally + memset(&g.DragDropPayloadBufLocal, 0, sizeof(g.DragDropPayloadBufLocal)); + payload.Data = g.DragDropPayloadBufLocal; + memcpy(payload.Data, data, data_size); + } + else + { + payload.Data = NULL; + } + payload.DataSize = (int)data_size; + } + payload.DataFrameCount = g.FrameCount; + + return (g.DragDropAcceptFrameCount == g.FrameCount) || (g.DragDropAcceptFrameCount == g.FrameCount - 1); +} + +bool ImGui::BeginDragDropTargetCustom(const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + if (!g.DragDropActive) + return false; + + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + ImGuiWindow* hovered_window = g.HoveredWindowUnderMovingWindow; + if (hovered_window == NULL || window->RootWindow != hovered_window->RootWindow) + return false; + IM_ASSERT(id != 0); + if (!IsMouseHoveringRect(bb.Min, bb.Max) || (id == g.DragDropPayload.SourceId)) + return false; + if (window->SkipItems) + return false; + + IM_ASSERT(g.DragDropWithinTarget == false); + g.DragDropTargetRect = bb; + g.DragDropTargetId = id; + g.DragDropWithinTarget = true; + return true; +} + +// We don't use BeginDragDropTargetCustom() and duplicate its code because: +// 1) we use LastItemRectHoveredRect which handles items that pushes a temporarily clip rectangle in their code. Calling BeginDragDropTargetCustom(LastItemRect) would not handle them. +// 2) and it's faster. as this code may be very frequently called, we want to early out as fast as we can. +// Also note how the HoveredWindow test is positioned differently in both functions (in both functions we optimize for the cheapest early out case) +bool ImGui::BeginDragDropTarget() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + if (!g.DragDropActive) + return false; + + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + if (!(g.LastItemData.StatusFlags & ImGuiItemStatusFlags_HoveredRect)) + return false; + ImGuiWindow* hovered_window = g.HoveredWindowUnderMovingWindow; + if (hovered_window == NULL || window->RootWindow != hovered_window->RootWindow) + return false; + + const ImRect& display_rect = (g.LastItemData.StatusFlags & ImGuiItemStatusFlags_HasDisplayRect) ? g.LastItemData.DisplayRect : g.LastItemData.Rect; + ImGuiID id = g.LastItemData.ID; + if (id == 0) + id = window->GetIDFromRectangle(display_rect); + if (g.DragDropPayload.SourceId == id) + return false; + + IM_ASSERT(g.DragDropWithinTarget == false); + g.DragDropTargetRect = display_rect; + g.DragDropTargetId = id; + g.DragDropWithinTarget = true; + return true; +} + +bool ImGui::IsDragDropPayloadBeingAccepted() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + return g.DragDropActive && g.DragDropAcceptIdPrev != 0; +} + +const ImGuiPayload* ImGui::AcceptDragDropPayload(const char* type, ImGuiDragDropFlags flags) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + ImGuiPayload& payload = g.DragDropPayload; + IM_ASSERT(g.DragDropActive); // Not called between BeginDragDropTarget() and EndDragDropTarget() ? + IM_ASSERT(payload.DataFrameCount != -1); // Forgot to call EndDragDropTarget() ? + if (type != NULL && !payload.IsDataType(type)) + return NULL; + + // Accept smallest drag target bounding box, this allows us to nest drag targets conveniently without ordering constraints. + // NB: We currently accept NULL id as target. However, overlapping targets requires a unique ID to function! + const bool was_accepted_previously = (g.DragDropAcceptIdPrev == g.DragDropTargetId); + ImRect r = g.DragDropTargetRect; + float r_surface = r.GetWidth() * r.GetHeight(); + if (r_surface <= g.DragDropAcceptIdCurrRectSurface) + { + g.DragDropAcceptFlags = flags; + g.DragDropAcceptIdCurr = g.DragDropTargetId; + g.DragDropAcceptIdCurrRectSurface = r_surface; + } + + // Render default drop visuals + // FIXME-DRAGDROP: Settle on a proper default visuals for drop target. + payload.Preview = was_accepted_previously; + flags |= (g.DragDropSourceFlags & ImGuiDragDropFlags_AcceptNoDrawDefaultRect); // Source can also inhibit the preview (useful for external sources that lives for 1 frame) + if (!(flags & ImGuiDragDropFlags_AcceptNoDrawDefaultRect) && payload.Preview) + window->DrawList->AddRect(r.Min - ImVec2(3.5f,3.5f), r.Max + ImVec2(3.5f, 3.5f), GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_DragDropTarget), 0.0f, 0, 2.0f); + + g.DragDropAcceptFrameCount = g.FrameCount; + payload.Delivery = was_accepted_previously && !IsMouseDown(g.DragDropMouseButton); // For extern drag sources affecting os window focus, it's easier to just test !IsMouseDown() instead of IsMouseReleased() + if (!payload.Delivery && !(flags & ImGuiDragDropFlags_AcceptBeforeDelivery)) + return NULL; + + return &payload; +} + +const ImGuiPayload* ImGui::GetDragDropPayload() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + return g.DragDropActive ? &g.DragDropPayload : NULL; +} + +// We don't really use/need this now, but added it for the sake of consistency and because we might need it later. +void ImGui::EndDragDropTarget() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + IM_ASSERT(g.DragDropActive); + IM_ASSERT(g.DragDropWithinTarget); + g.DragDropWithinTarget = false; +} + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] LOGGING/CAPTURING +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// All text output from the interface can be captured into tty/file/clipboard. +// By default, tree nodes are automatically opened during logging. +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// Pass text data straight to log (without being displayed) +static inline void LogTextV(ImGuiContext& g, const char* fmt, va_list args) +{ + if (g.LogFile) + { + g.LogBuffer.Buf.resize(0); + g.LogBuffer.appendfv(fmt, args); + ImFileWrite(g.LogBuffer.c_str(), sizeof(char), (ImU64)g.LogBuffer.size(), g.LogFile); + } + else + { + g.LogBuffer.appendfv(fmt, args); + } +} + +void ImGui::LogText(const char* fmt, ...) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + if (!g.LogEnabled) + return; + + va_list args; + va_start(args, fmt); + LogTextV(g, fmt, args); + va_end(args); +} + +void ImGui::LogTextV(const char* fmt, va_list args) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + if (!g.LogEnabled) + return; + + LogTextV(g, fmt, args); +} + +// Internal version that takes a position to decide on newline placement and pad items according to their depth. +// We split text into individual lines to add current tree level padding +// FIXME: This code is a little complicated perhaps, considering simplifying the whole system. +void ImGui::LogRenderedText(const ImVec2* ref_pos, const char* text, const char* text_end) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + + const char* prefix = g.LogNextPrefix; + const char* suffix = g.LogNextSuffix; + g.LogNextPrefix = g.LogNextSuffix = NULL; + + if (!text_end) + text_end = FindRenderedTextEnd(text, text_end); + + const bool log_new_line = ref_pos && (ref_pos->y > g.LogLinePosY + g.Style.FramePadding.y + 1); + if (ref_pos) + g.LogLinePosY = ref_pos->y; + if (log_new_line) + { + LogText(IM_NEWLINE); + g.LogLineFirstItem = true; + } + + if (prefix) + LogRenderedText(ref_pos, prefix, prefix + strlen(prefix)); // Calculate end ourself to ensure "##" are included here. + + // Re-adjust padding if we have popped out of our starting depth + if (g.LogDepthRef > window->DC.TreeDepth) + g.LogDepthRef = window->DC.TreeDepth; + const int tree_depth = (window->DC.TreeDepth - g.LogDepthRef); + + const char* text_remaining = text; + for (;;) + { + // Split the string. Each new line (after a '\n') is followed by indentation corresponding to the current depth of our log entry. + // We don't add a trailing \n yet to allow a subsequent item on the same line to be captured. + const char* line_start = text_remaining; + const char* line_end = ImStreolRange(line_start, text_end); + const bool is_last_line = (line_end == text_end); + if (line_start != line_end || !is_last_line) + { + const int line_length = (int)(line_end - line_start); + const int indentation = g.LogLineFirstItem ? tree_depth * 4 : 1; + LogText("%*s%.*s", indentation, "", line_length, line_start); + g.LogLineFirstItem = false; + if (*line_end == '\n') + { + LogText(IM_NEWLINE); + g.LogLineFirstItem = true; + } + } + if (is_last_line) + break; + text_remaining = line_end + 1; + } + + if (suffix) + LogRenderedText(ref_pos, suffix, suffix + strlen(suffix)); +} + +// Start logging/capturing text output +void ImGui::LogBegin(ImGuiLogType type, int auto_open_depth) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + IM_ASSERT(g.LogEnabled == false); + IM_ASSERT(g.LogFile == NULL); + IM_ASSERT(g.LogBuffer.empty()); + g.LogEnabled = true; + g.LogType = type; + g.LogNextPrefix = g.LogNextSuffix = NULL; + g.LogDepthRef = window->DC.TreeDepth; + g.LogDepthToExpand = ((auto_open_depth >= 0) ? auto_open_depth : g.LogDepthToExpandDefault); + g.LogLinePosY = FLT_MAX; + g.LogLineFirstItem = true; +} + +// Important: doesn't copy underlying data, use carefully (prefix/suffix must be in scope at the time of the next LogRenderedText) +void ImGui::LogSetNextTextDecoration(const char* prefix, const char* suffix) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + g.LogNextPrefix = prefix; + g.LogNextSuffix = suffix; +} + +void ImGui::LogToTTY(int auto_open_depth) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + if (g.LogEnabled) + return; + IM_UNUSED(auto_open_depth); +#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_TTY_FUNCTIONS + LogBegin(ImGuiLogType_TTY, auto_open_depth); + g.LogFile = stdout; +#endif +} + +// Start logging/capturing text output to given file +void ImGui::LogToFile(int auto_open_depth, const char* filename) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + if (g.LogEnabled) + return; + + // FIXME: We could probably open the file in text mode "at", however note that clipboard/buffer logging will still + // be subject to outputting OS-incompatible carriage return if within strings the user doesn't use IM_NEWLINE. + // By opening the file in binary mode "ab" we have consistent output everywhere. + if (!filename) + filename = g.IO.LogFilename; + if (!filename || !filename[0]) + return; + ImFileHandle f = ImFileOpen(filename, "ab"); + if (!f) + { + IM_ASSERT(0); + return; + } + + LogBegin(ImGuiLogType_File, auto_open_depth); + g.LogFile = f; +} + +// Start logging/capturing text output to clipboard +void ImGui::LogToClipboard(int auto_open_depth) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + if (g.LogEnabled) + return; + LogBegin(ImGuiLogType_Clipboard, auto_open_depth); +} + +void ImGui::LogToBuffer(int auto_open_depth) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + if (g.LogEnabled) + return; + LogBegin(ImGuiLogType_Buffer, auto_open_depth); +} + +void ImGui::LogFinish() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + if (!g.LogEnabled) + return; + + LogText(IM_NEWLINE); + switch (g.LogType) + { + case ImGuiLogType_TTY: +#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_TTY_FUNCTIONS + fflush(g.LogFile); +#endif + break; + case ImGuiLogType_File: + ImFileClose(g.LogFile); + break; + case ImGuiLogType_Buffer: + break; + case ImGuiLogType_Clipboard: + if (!g.LogBuffer.empty()) + SetClipboardText(g.LogBuffer.begin()); + break; + case ImGuiLogType_None: + IM_ASSERT(0); + break; + } + + g.LogEnabled = false; + g.LogType = ImGuiLogType_None; + g.LogFile = NULL; + g.LogBuffer.clear(); +} + +// Helper to display logging buttons +// FIXME-OBSOLETE: We should probably obsolete this and let the user have their own helper (this is one of the oldest function alive!) +void ImGui::LogButtons() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + + PushID("LogButtons"); +#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_TTY_FUNCTIONS + const bool log_to_tty = Button("Log To TTY"); SameLine(); +#else + const bool log_to_tty = false; +#endif + const bool log_to_file = Button("Log To File"); SameLine(); + const bool log_to_clipboard = Button("Log To Clipboard"); SameLine(); + PushAllowKeyboardFocus(false); + SetNextItemWidth(80.0f); + SliderInt("Default Depth", &g.LogDepthToExpandDefault, 0, 9, NULL); + PopAllowKeyboardFocus(); + PopID(); + + // Start logging at the end of the function so that the buttons don't appear in the log + if (log_to_tty) + LogToTTY(); + if (log_to_file) + LogToFile(); + if (log_to_clipboard) + LogToClipboard(); +} + + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] SETTINGS +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// - UpdateSettings() [Internal] +// - MarkIniSettingsDirty() [Internal] +// - CreateNewWindowSettings() [Internal] +// - FindWindowSettings() [Internal] +// - FindOrCreateWindowSettings() [Internal] +// - FindSettingsHandler() [Internal] +// - ClearIniSettings() [Internal] +// - LoadIniSettingsFromDisk() +// - LoadIniSettingsFromMemory() +// - SaveIniSettingsToDisk() +// - SaveIniSettingsToMemory() +// - WindowSettingsHandler_***() [Internal] +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// Called by NewFrame() +void ImGui::UpdateSettings() +{ + // Load settings on first frame (if not explicitly loaded manually before) + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + if (!g.SettingsLoaded) + { + IM_ASSERT(g.SettingsWindows.empty()); + if (g.IO.IniFilename) + LoadIniSettingsFromDisk(g.IO.IniFilename); + g.SettingsLoaded = true; + } + + // Save settings (with a delay after the last modification, so we don't spam disk too much) + if (g.SettingsDirtyTimer > 0.0f) + { + g.SettingsDirtyTimer -= g.IO.DeltaTime; + if (g.SettingsDirtyTimer <= 0.0f) + { + if (g.IO.IniFilename != NULL) + SaveIniSettingsToDisk(g.IO.IniFilename); + else + g.IO.WantSaveIniSettings = true; // Let user know they can call SaveIniSettingsToMemory(). user will need to clear io.WantSaveIniSettings themselves. + g.SettingsDirtyTimer = 0.0f; + } + } +} + +void ImGui::MarkIniSettingsDirty() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + if (g.SettingsDirtyTimer <= 0.0f) + g.SettingsDirtyTimer = g.IO.IniSavingRate; +} + +void ImGui::MarkIniSettingsDirty(ImGuiWindow* window) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + if (!(window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoSavedSettings)) + if (g.SettingsDirtyTimer <= 0.0f) + g.SettingsDirtyTimer = g.IO.IniSavingRate; +} + +ImGuiWindowSettings* ImGui::CreateNewWindowSettings(const char* name) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + +#if !IMGUI_DEBUG_INI_SETTINGS + // Skip to the "###" marker if any. We don't skip past to match the behavior of GetID() + // Preserve the full string when IMGUI_DEBUG_INI_SETTINGS is set to make .ini inspection easier. + if (const char* p = strstr(name, "###")) + name = p; +#endif + const size_t name_len = strlen(name); + + // Allocate chunk + const size_t chunk_size = sizeof(ImGuiWindowSettings) + name_len + 1; + ImGuiWindowSettings* settings = g.SettingsWindows.alloc_chunk(chunk_size); + IM_PLACEMENT_NEW(settings) ImGuiWindowSettings(); + settings->ID = ImHashStr(name, name_len); + memcpy(settings->GetName(), name, name_len + 1); // Store with zero terminator + + return settings; +} + +ImGuiWindowSettings* ImGui::FindWindowSettings(ImGuiID id) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + for (ImGuiWindowSettings* settings = g.SettingsWindows.begin(); settings != NULL; settings = g.SettingsWindows.next_chunk(settings)) + if (settings->ID == id) + return settings; + return NULL; +} + +ImGuiWindowSettings* ImGui::FindOrCreateWindowSettings(const char* name) +{ + if (ImGuiWindowSettings* settings = FindWindowSettings(ImHashStr(name))) + return settings; + return CreateNewWindowSettings(name); +} + +ImGuiSettingsHandler* ImGui::FindSettingsHandler(const char* type_name) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + const ImGuiID type_hash = ImHashStr(type_name); + for (int handler_n = 0; handler_n < g.SettingsHandlers.Size; handler_n++) + if (g.SettingsHandlers[handler_n].TypeHash == type_hash) + return &g.SettingsHandlers[handler_n]; + return NULL; +} + +void ImGui::ClearIniSettings() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + g.SettingsIniData.clear(); + for (int handler_n = 0; handler_n < g.SettingsHandlers.Size; handler_n++) + if (g.SettingsHandlers[handler_n].ClearAllFn) + g.SettingsHandlers[handler_n].ClearAllFn(&g, &g.SettingsHandlers[handler_n]); +} + +void ImGui::LoadIniSettingsFromDisk(const char* ini_filename) +{ + size_t file_data_size = 0; + char* file_data = (char*)ImFileLoadToMemory(ini_filename, "rb", &file_data_size); + if (!file_data) + return; + LoadIniSettingsFromMemory(file_data, (size_t)file_data_size); + IM_FREE(file_data); +} + +// Zero-tolerance, no error reporting, cheap .ini parsing +void ImGui::LoadIniSettingsFromMemory(const char* ini_data, size_t ini_size) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + IM_ASSERT(g.Initialized); + //IM_ASSERT(!g.WithinFrameScope && "Cannot be called between NewFrame() and EndFrame()"); + //IM_ASSERT(g.SettingsLoaded == false && g.FrameCount == 0); + + // For user convenience, we allow passing a non zero-terminated string (hence the ini_size parameter). + // For our convenience and to make the code simpler, we'll also write zero-terminators within the buffer. So let's create a writable copy.. + if (ini_size == 0) + ini_size = strlen(ini_data); + g.SettingsIniData.Buf.resize((int)ini_size + 1); + char* const buf = g.SettingsIniData.Buf.Data; + char* const buf_end = buf + ini_size; + memcpy(buf, ini_data, ini_size); + buf_end[0] = 0; + + // Call pre-read handlers + // Some types will clear their data (e.g. dock information) some types will allow merge/override (window) + for (int handler_n = 0; handler_n < g.SettingsHandlers.Size; handler_n++) + if (g.SettingsHandlers[handler_n].ReadInitFn) + g.SettingsHandlers[handler_n].ReadInitFn(&g, &g.SettingsHandlers[handler_n]); + + void* entry_data = NULL; + ImGuiSettingsHandler* entry_handler = NULL; + + char* line_end = NULL; + for (char* line = buf; line < buf_end; line = line_end + 1) + { + // Skip new lines markers, then find end of the line + while (*line == '\n' || *line == '\r') + line++; + line_end = line; + while (line_end < buf_end && *line_end != '\n' && *line_end != '\r') + line_end++; + line_end[0] = 0; + if (line[0] == ';') + continue; + if (line[0] == '[' && line_end > line && line_end[-1] == ']') + { + // Parse "[Type][Name]". Note that 'Name' can itself contains [] characters, which is acceptable with the current format and parsing code. + line_end[-1] = 0; + const char* name_end = line_end - 1; + const char* type_start = line + 1; + char* type_end = (char*)(void*)ImStrchrRange(type_start, name_end, ']'); + const char* name_start = type_end ? ImStrchrRange(type_end + 1, name_end, '[') : NULL; + if (!type_end || !name_start) + continue; + *type_end = 0; // Overwrite first ']' + name_start++; // Skip second '[' + entry_handler = FindSettingsHandler(type_start); + entry_data = entry_handler ? entry_handler->ReadOpenFn(&g, entry_handler, name_start) : NULL; + } + else if (entry_handler != NULL && entry_data != NULL) + { + // Let type handler parse the line + entry_handler->ReadLineFn(&g, entry_handler, entry_data, line); + } + } + g.SettingsLoaded = true; + + // [DEBUG] Restore untouched copy so it can be browsed in Metrics (not strictly necessary) + memcpy(buf, ini_data, ini_size); + + // Call post-read handlers + for (int handler_n = 0; handler_n < g.SettingsHandlers.Size; handler_n++) + if (g.SettingsHandlers[handler_n].ApplyAllFn) + g.SettingsHandlers[handler_n].ApplyAllFn(&g, &g.SettingsHandlers[handler_n]); +} + +void ImGui::SaveIniSettingsToDisk(const char* ini_filename) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + g.SettingsDirtyTimer = 0.0f; + if (!ini_filename) + return; + + size_t ini_data_size = 0; + const char* ini_data = SaveIniSettingsToMemory(&ini_data_size); + ImFileHandle f = ImFileOpen(ini_filename, "wt"); + if (!f) + return; + ImFileWrite(ini_data, sizeof(char), ini_data_size, f); + ImFileClose(f); +} + +// Call registered handlers (e.g. SettingsHandlerWindow_WriteAll() + custom handlers) to write their stuff into a text buffer +const char* ImGui::SaveIniSettingsToMemory(size_t* out_size) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + g.SettingsDirtyTimer = 0.0f; + g.SettingsIniData.Buf.resize(0); + g.SettingsIniData.Buf.push_back(0); + for (int handler_n = 0; handler_n < g.SettingsHandlers.Size; handler_n++) + { + ImGuiSettingsHandler* handler = &g.SettingsHandlers[handler_n]; + handler->WriteAllFn(&g, handler, &g.SettingsIniData); + } + if (out_size) + *out_size = (size_t)g.SettingsIniData.size(); + return g.SettingsIniData.c_str(); +} + +static void WindowSettingsHandler_ClearAll(ImGuiContext* ctx, ImGuiSettingsHandler*) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *ctx; + for (int i = 0; i != g.Windows.Size; i++) + g.Windows[i]->SettingsOffset = -1; + g.SettingsWindows.clear(); +} + +static void* WindowSettingsHandler_ReadOpen(ImGuiContext*, ImGuiSettingsHandler*, const char* name) +{ + ImGuiWindowSettings* settings = ImGui::FindOrCreateWindowSettings(name); + ImGuiID id = settings->ID; + *settings = ImGuiWindowSettings(); // Clear existing if recycling previous entry + settings->ID = id; + settings->WantApply = true; + return (void*)settings; +} + +static void WindowSettingsHandler_ReadLine(ImGuiContext*, ImGuiSettingsHandler*, void* entry, const char* line) +{ + ImGuiWindowSettings* settings = (ImGuiWindowSettings*)entry; + int x, y; + int i; + if (sscanf(line, "Pos=%i,%i", &x, &y) == 2) { settings->Pos = ImVec2ih((short)x, (short)y); } + else if (sscanf(line, "Size=%i,%i", &x, &y) == 2) { settings->Size = ImVec2ih((short)x, (short)y); } + else if (sscanf(line, "Collapsed=%d", &i) == 1) { settings->Collapsed = (i != 0); } +} + +// Apply to existing windows (if any) +static void WindowSettingsHandler_ApplyAll(ImGuiContext* ctx, ImGuiSettingsHandler*) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *ctx; + for (ImGuiWindowSettings* settings = g.SettingsWindows.begin(); settings != NULL; settings = g.SettingsWindows.next_chunk(settings)) + if (settings->WantApply) + { + if (ImGuiWindow* window = ImGui::FindWindowByID(settings->ID)) + ApplyWindowSettings(window, settings); + settings->WantApply = false; + } +} + +static void WindowSettingsHandler_WriteAll(ImGuiContext* ctx, ImGuiSettingsHandler* handler, ImGuiTextBuffer* buf) +{ + // Gather data from windows that were active during this session + // (if a window wasn't opened in this session we preserve its settings) + ImGuiContext& g = *ctx; + for (int i = 0; i != g.Windows.Size; i++) + { + ImGuiWindow* window = g.Windows[i]; + if (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoSavedSettings) + continue; + + ImGuiWindowSettings* settings = (window->SettingsOffset != -1) ? g.SettingsWindows.ptr_from_offset(window->SettingsOffset) : ImGui::FindWindowSettings(window->ID); + if (!settings) + { + settings = ImGui::CreateNewWindowSettings(window->Name); + window->SettingsOffset = g.SettingsWindows.offset_from_ptr(settings); + } + IM_ASSERT(settings->ID == window->ID); + settings->Pos = ImVec2ih(window->Pos); + settings->Size = ImVec2ih(window->SizeFull); + + settings->Collapsed = window->Collapsed; + } + + // Write to text buffer + buf->reserve(buf->size() + g.SettingsWindows.size() * 6); // ballpark reserve + for (ImGuiWindowSettings* settings = g.SettingsWindows.begin(); settings != NULL; settings = g.SettingsWindows.next_chunk(settings)) + { + const char* settings_name = settings->GetName(); + buf->appendf("[%s][%s]\n", handler->TypeName, settings_name); + buf->appendf("Pos=%d,%d\n", settings->Pos.x, settings->Pos.y); + buf->appendf("Size=%d,%d\n", settings->Size.x, settings->Size.y); + buf->appendf("Collapsed=%d\n", settings->Collapsed); + buf->append("\n"); + } +} + + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] VIEWPORTS, PLATFORM WINDOWS +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// - GetMainViewport() +// - UpdateViewportsNewFrame() [Internal] +// (this section is more complete in the 'docking' branch) +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +ImGuiViewport* ImGui::GetMainViewport() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + return g.Viewports[0]; +} + +// Update viewports and monitor infos +static void ImGui::UpdateViewportsNewFrame() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + IM_ASSERT(g.Viewports.Size == 1); + + // Update main viewport with current platform position. + // FIXME-VIEWPORT: Size is driven by backend/user code for backward-compatibility but we should aim to make this more consistent. + ImGuiViewportP* main_viewport = g.Viewports[0]; + main_viewport->Flags = ImGuiViewportFlags_IsPlatformWindow | ImGuiViewportFlags_OwnedByApp; + main_viewport->Pos = ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f); + main_viewport->Size = g.IO.DisplaySize; + + for (int n = 0; n < g.Viewports.Size; n++) + { + ImGuiViewportP* viewport = g.Viewports[n]; + + // Lock down space taken by menu bars and status bars, reset the offset for fucntions like BeginMainMenuBar() to alter them again. + viewport->WorkOffsetMin = viewport->BuildWorkOffsetMin; + viewport->WorkOffsetMax = viewport->BuildWorkOffsetMax; + viewport->BuildWorkOffsetMin = viewport->BuildWorkOffsetMax = ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f); + viewport->UpdateWorkRect(); + } +} + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] DOCKING +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// (this section is filled in the 'docking' branch) + + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] PLATFORM DEPENDENT HELPERS +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +#if defined(_WIN32) && !defined(IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_FUNCTIONS) && !defined(IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_DEFAULT_CLIPBOARD_FUNCTIONS) + +#ifdef _MSC_VER +#pragma comment(lib, "user32") +#pragma comment(lib, "kernel32") +#endif + +// Win32 clipboard implementation +// We use g.ClipboardHandlerData for temporary storage to ensure it is freed on Shutdown() +static const char* GetClipboardTextFn_DefaultImpl(void*) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + g.ClipboardHandlerData.clear(); + if (!::OpenClipboard(NULL)) + return NULL; + HANDLE wbuf_handle = ::GetClipboardData(CF_UNICODETEXT); + if (wbuf_handle == NULL) + { + ::CloseClipboard(); + return NULL; + } + if (const WCHAR* wbuf_global = (const WCHAR*)::GlobalLock(wbuf_handle)) + { + int buf_len = ::WideCharToMultiByte(CP_UTF8, 0, wbuf_global, -1, NULL, 0, NULL, NULL); + g.ClipboardHandlerData.resize(buf_len); + ::WideCharToMultiByte(CP_UTF8, 0, wbuf_global, -1, g.ClipboardHandlerData.Data, buf_len, NULL, NULL); + } + ::GlobalUnlock(wbuf_handle); + ::CloseClipboard(); + return g.ClipboardHandlerData.Data; +} + +static void SetClipboardTextFn_DefaultImpl(void*, const char* text) +{ + if (!::OpenClipboard(NULL)) + return; + const int wbuf_length = ::MultiByteToWideChar(CP_UTF8, 0, text, -1, NULL, 0); + HGLOBAL wbuf_handle = ::GlobalAlloc(GMEM_MOVEABLE, (SIZE_T)wbuf_length * sizeof(WCHAR)); + if (wbuf_handle == NULL) + { + ::CloseClipboard(); + return; + } + WCHAR* wbuf_global = (WCHAR*)::GlobalLock(wbuf_handle); + ::MultiByteToWideChar(CP_UTF8, 0, text, -1, wbuf_global, wbuf_length); + ::GlobalUnlock(wbuf_handle); + ::EmptyClipboard(); + if (::SetClipboardData(CF_UNICODETEXT, wbuf_handle) == NULL) + ::GlobalFree(wbuf_handle); + ::CloseClipboard(); +} + +#elif defined(__APPLE__) && TARGET_OS_OSX && defined(IMGUI_ENABLE_OSX_DEFAULT_CLIPBOARD_FUNCTIONS) + +#include // Use old API to avoid need for separate .mm file +static PasteboardRef main_clipboard = 0; + +// OSX clipboard implementation +// If you enable this you will need to add '-framework ApplicationServices' to your linker command-line! +static void SetClipboardTextFn_DefaultImpl(void*, const char* text) +{ + if (!main_clipboard) + PasteboardCreate(kPasteboardClipboard, &main_clipboard); + PasteboardClear(main_clipboard); + CFDataRef cf_data = CFDataCreate(kCFAllocatorDefault, (const UInt8*)text, strlen(text)); + if (cf_data) + { + PasteboardPutItemFlavor(main_clipboard, (PasteboardItemID)1, CFSTR("public.utf8-plain-text"), cf_data, 0); + CFRelease(cf_data); + } +} + +static const char* GetClipboardTextFn_DefaultImpl(void*) +{ + if (!main_clipboard) + PasteboardCreate(kPasteboardClipboard, &main_clipboard); + PasteboardSynchronize(main_clipboard); + + ItemCount item_count = 0; + PasteboardGetItemCount(main_clipboard, &item_count); + for (ItemCount i = 0; i < item_count; i++) + { + PasteboardItemID item_id = 0; + PasteboardGetItemIdentifier(main_clipboard, i + 1, &item_id); + CFArrayRef flavor_type_array = 0; + PasteboardCopyItemFlavors(main_clipboard, item_id, &flavor_type_array); + for (CFIndex j = 0, nj = CFArrayGetCount(flavor_type_array); j < nj; j++) + { + CFDataRef cf_data; + if (PasteboardCopyItemFlavorData(main_clipboard, item_id, CFSTR("public.utf8-plain-text"), &cf_data) == noErr) + { + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + g.ClipboardHandlerData.clear(); + int length = (int)CFDataGetLength(cf_data); + g.ClipboardHandlerData.resize(length + 1); + CFDataGetBytes(cf_data, CFRangeMake(0, length), (UInt8*)g.ClipboardHandlerData.Data); + g.ClipboardHandlerData[length] = 0; + CFRelease(cf_data); + return g.ClipboardHandlerData.Data; + } + } + } + return NULL; +} + +#else + +// Local Dear ImGui-only clipboard implementation, if user hasn't defined better clipboard handlers. +static const char* GetClipboardTextFn_DefaultImpl(void*) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + return g.ClipboardHandlerData.empty() ? NULL : g.ClipboardHandlerData.begin(); +} + +static void SetClipboardTextFn_DefaultImpl(void*, const char* text) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + g.ClipboardHandlerData.clear(); + const char* text_end = text + strlen(text); + g.ClipboardHandlerData.resize((int)(text_end - text) + 1); + memcpy(&g.ClipboardHandlerData[0], text, (size_t)(text_end - text)); + g.ClipboardHandlerData[(int)(text_end - text)] = 0; +} + +#endif + +// Win32 API IME support (for Asian languages, etc.) +#if defined(_WIN32) && !defined(IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_FUNCTIONS) && !defined(IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_DEFAULT_IME_FUNCTIONS) + +#include +#ifdef _MSC_VER +#pragma comment(lib, "imm32") +#endif + +static void ImeSetInputScreenPosFn_DefaultImpl(int x, int y) +{ + // Notify OS Input Method Editor of text input position + ImGuiIO& io = ImGui::GetIO(); + if (HWND hwnd = (HWND)io.ImeWindowHandle) + if (HIMC himc = ::ImmGetContext(hwnd)) + { + COMPOSITIONFORM cf; + cf.ptCurrentPos.x = x; + cf.ptCurrentPos.y = y; + cf.dwStyle = CFS_FORCE_POSITION; + ::ImmSetCompositionWindow(himc, &cf); + ::ImmReleaseContext(hwnd, himc); + } +} + +#else + +static void ImeSetInputScreenPosFn_DefaultImpl(int, int) {} + +#endif + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] METRICS/DEBUGGER WINDOW +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// - RenderViewportThumbnail() [Internal] +// - RenderViewportsThumbnails() [Internal] +// - MetricsHelpMarker() [Internal] +// - ShowMetricsWindow() +// - DebugNodeColumns() [Internal] +// - DebugNodeDrawList() [Internal] +// - DebugNodeDrawCmdShowMeshAndBoundingBox() [Internal] +// - DebugNodeStorage() [Internal] +// - DebugNodeTabBar() [Internal] +// - DebugNodeViewport() [Internal] +// - DebugNodeWindow() [Internal] +// - DebugNodeWindowSettings() [Internal] +// - DebugNodeWindowsList() [Internal] +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_METRICS_WINDOW + +void ImGui::DebugRenderViewportThumbnail(ImDrawList* draw_list, ImGuiViewportP* viewport, const ImRect& bb) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + + ImVec2 scale = bb.GetSize() / viewport->Size; + ImVec2 off = bb.Min - viewport->Pos * scale; + float alpha_mul = 1.0f; + window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(bb.Min, bb.Max, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Border, alpha_mul * 0.40f)); + for (int i = 0; i != g.Windows.Size; i++) + { + ImGuiWindow* thumb_window = g.Windows[i]; + if (!thumb_window->WasActive || (thumb_window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow)) + continue; + + ImRect thumb_r = thumb_window->Rect(); + ImRect title_r = thumb_window->TitleBarRect(); + thumb_r = ImRect(ImFloor(off + thumb_r.Min * scale), ImFloor(off + thumb_r.Max * scale)); + title_r = ImRect(ImFloor(off + title_r.Min * scale), ImFloor(off + ImVec2(title_r.Max.x, title_r.Min.y) * scale) + ImVec2(0,5)); // Exaggerate title bar height + thumb_r.ClipWithFull(bb); + title_r.ClipWithFull(bb); + const bool window_is_focused = (g.NavWindow && thumb_window->RootWindowForTitleBarHighlight == g.NavWindow->RootWindowForTitleBarHighlight); + window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(thumb_r.Min, thumb_r.Max, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_WindowBg, alpha_mul)); + window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(title_r.Min, title_r.Max, GetColorU32(window_is_focused ? ImGuiCol_TitleBgActive : ImGuiCol_TitleBg, alpha_mul)); + window->DrawList->AddRect(thumb_r.Min, thumb_r.Max, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Border, alpha_mul)); + window->DrawList->AddText(g.Font, g.FontSize * 1.0f, title_r.Min, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text, alpha_mul), thumb_window->Name, FindRenderedTextEnd(thumb_window->Name)); + } + draw_list->AddRect(bb.Min, bb.Max, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Border, alpha_mul)); +} + +static void RenderViewportsThumbnails() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + + // We don't display full monitor bounds (we could, but it often looks awkward), instead we display just enough to cover all of our viewports. + float SCALE = 1.0f / 8.0f; + ImRect bb_full(FLT_MAX, FLT_MAX, -FLT_MAX, -FLT_MAX); + for (int n = 0; n < g.Viewports.Size; n++) + bb_full.Add(g.Viewports[n]->GetMainRect()); + ImVec2 p = window->DC.CursorPos; + ImVec2 off = p - bb_full.Min * SCALE; + for (int n = 0; n < g.Viewports.Size; n++) + { + ImGuiViewportP* viewport = g.Viewports[n]; + ImRect viewport_draw_bb(off + (viewport->Pos) * SCALE, off + (viewport->Pos + viewport->Size) * SCALE); + ImGui::DebugRenderViewportThumbnail(window->DrawList, viewport, viewport_draw_bb); + } + ImGui::Dummy(bb_full.GetSize() * SCALE); +} + +// Avoid naming collision with imgui_demo.cpp's HelpMarker() for unity builds. +static void MetricsHelpMarker(const char* desc) +{ + ImGui::TextDisabled("(?)"); + if (ImGui::IsItemHovered()) + { + ImGui::BeginTooltip(); + ImGui::PushTextWrapPos(ImGui::GetFontSize() * 35.0f); + ImGui::TextUnformatted(desc); + ImGui::PopTextWrapPos(); + ImGui::EndTooltip(); + } +} + +#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_DEMO_WINDOWS +namespace ImGui { void ShowFontAtlas(ImFontAtlas* atlas); } +#endif + +void ImGui::ShowMetricsWindow(bool* p_open) +{ + if (!Begin("Dear ImGui Metrics/Debugger", p_open)) + { + End(); + return; + } + + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiIO& io = g.IO; + ImGuiMetricsConfig* cfg = &g.DebugMetricsConfig; + + // Basic info + Text("Dear ImGui %s", GetVersion()); + Text("Application average %.3f ms/frame (%.1f FPS)", 1000.0f / io.Framerate, io.Framerate); + Text("%d vertices, %d indices (%d triangles)", io.MetricsRenderVertices, io.MetricsRenderIndices, io.MetricsRenderIndices / 3); + Text("%d active windows (%d visible)", io.MetricsActiveWindows, io.MetricsRenderWindows); + Text("%d active allocations", io.MetricsActiveAllocations); + //SameLine(); if (SmallButton("GC")) { g.GcCompactAll = true; } + + Separator(); + + // Debugging enums + enum { WRT_OuterRect, WRT_OuterRectClipped, WRT_InnerRect, WRT_InnerClipRect, WRT_WorkRect, WRT_Content, WRT_ContentIdeal, WRT_ContentRegionRect, WRT_Count }; // Windows Rect Type + const char* wrt_rects_names[WRT_Count] = { "OuterRect", "OuterRectClipped", "InnerRect", "InnerClipRect", "WorkRect", "Content", "ContentIdeal", "ContentRegionRect" }; + enum { TRT_OuterRect, TRT_InnerRect, TRT_WorkRect, TRT_HostClipRect, TRT_InnerClipRect, TRT_BackgroundClipRect, TRT_ColumnsRect, TRT_ColumnsWorkRect, TRT_ColumnsClipRect, TRT_ColumnsContentHeadersUsed, TRT_ColumnsContentHeadersIdeal, TRT_ColumnsContentFrozen, TRT_ColumnsContentUnfrozen, TRT_Count }; // Tables Rect Type + const char* trt_rects_names[TRT_Count] = { "OuterRect", "InnerRect", "WorkRect", "HostClipRect", "InnerClipRect", "BackgroundClipRect", "ColumnsRect", "ColumnsWorkRect", "ColumnsClipRect", "ColumnsContentHeadersUsed", "ColumnsContentHeadersIdeal", "ColumnsContentFrozen", "ColumnsContentUnfrozen" }; + if (cfg->ShowWindowsRectsType < 0) + cfg->ShowWindowsRectsType = WRT_WorkRect; + if (cfg->ShowTablesRectsType < 0) + cfg->ShowTablesRectsType = TRT_WorkRect; + + struct Funcs + { + static ImRect GetTableRect(ImGuiTable* table, int rect_type, int n) + { + if (rect_type == TRT_OuterRect) { return table->OuterRect; } + else if (rect_type == TRT_InnerRect) { return table->InnerRect; } + else if (rect_type == TRT_WorkRect) { return table->WorkRect; } + else if (rect_type == TRT_HostClipRect) { return table->HostClipRect; } + else if (rect_type == TRT_InnerClipRect) { return table->InnerClipRect; } + else if (rect_type == TRT_BackgroundClipRect) { return table->BgClipRect; } + else if (rect_type == TRT_ColumnsRect) { ImGuiTableColumn* c = &table->Columns[n]; return ImRect(c->MinX, table->InnerClipRect.Min.y, c->MaxX, table->InnerClipRect.Min.y + table->LastOuterHeight); } + else if (rect_type == TRT_ColumnsWorkRect) { ImGuiTableColumn* c = &table->Columns[n]; return ImRect(c->WorkMinX, table->WorkRect.Min.y, c->WorkMaxX, table->WorkRect.Max.y); } + else if (rect_type == TRT_ColumnsClipRect) { ImGuiTableColumn* c = &table->Columns[n]; return c->ClipRect; } + else if (rect_type == TRT_ColumnsContentHeadersUsed){ ImGuiTableColumn* c = &table->Columns[n]; return ImRect(c->WorkMinX, table->InnerClipRect.Min.y, c->ContentMaxXHeadersUsed, table->InnerClipRect.Min.y + table->LastFirstRowHeight); } // Note: y1/y2 not always accurate + else if (rect_type == TRT_ColumnsContentHeadersIdeal){ImGuiTableColumn* c = &table->Columns[n]; return ImRect(c->WorkMinX, table->InnerClipRect.Min.y, c->ContentMaxXHeadersIdeal, table->InnerClipRect.Min.y + table->LastFirstRowHeight); } + else if (rect_type == TRT_ColumnsContentFrozen) { ImGuiTableColumn* c = &table->Columns[n]; return ImRect(c->WorkMinX, table->InnerClipRect.Min.y, c->ContentMaxXFrozen, table->InnerClipRect.Min.y + table->LastFirstRowHeight); } + else if (rect_type == TRT_ColumnsContentUnfrozen) { ImGuiTableColumn* c = &table->Columns[n]; return ImRect(c->WorkMinX, table->InnerClipRect.Min.y + table->LastFirstRowHeight, c->ContentMaxXUnfrozen, table->InnerClipRect.Max.y); } + IM_ASSERT(0); + return ImRect(); + } + + static ImRect GetWindowRect(ImGuiWindow* window, int rect_type) + { + if (rect_type == WRT_OuterRect) { return window->Rect(); } + else if (rect_type == WRT_OuterRectClipped) { return window->OuterRectClipped; } + else if (rect_type == WRT_InnerRect) { return window->InnerRect; } + else if (rect_type == WRT_InnerClipRect) { return window->InnerClipRect; } + else if (rect_type == WRT_WorkRect) { return window->WorkRect; } + else if (rect_type == WRT_Content) { ImVec2 min = window->InnerRect.Min - window->Scroll + window->WindowPadding; return ImRect(min, min + window->ContentSize); } + else if (rect_type == WRT_ContentIdeal) { ImVec2 min = window->InnerRect.Min - window->Scroll + window->WindowPadding; return ImRect(min, min + window->ContentSizeIdeal); } + else if (rect_type == WRT_ContentRegionRect) { return window->ContentRegionRect; } + IM_ASSERT(0); + return ImRect(); + } + }; + + // Tools + if (TreeNode("Tools")) + { + // The Item Picker tool is super useful to visually select an item and break into the call-stack of where it was submitted. + if (Button("Item Picker..")) + DebugStartItemPicker(); + SameLine(); + MetricsHelpMarker("Will call the IM_DEBUG_BREAK() macro to break in debugger.\nWarning: If you don't have a debugger attached, this will probably crash."); + + Checkbox("Show windows begin order", &cfg->ShowWindowsBeginOrder); + Checkbox("Show windows rectangles", &cfg->ShowWindowsRects); + SameLine(); + SetNextItemWidth(GetFontSize() * 12); + cfg->ShowWindowsRects |= Combo("##show_windows_rect_type", &cfg->ShowWindowsRectsType, wrt_rects_names, WRT_Count, WRT_Count); + if (cfg->ShowWindowsRects && g.NavWindow != NULL) + { + BulletText("'%s':", g.NavWindow->Name); + Indent(); + for (int rect_n = 0; rect_n < WRT_Count; rect_n++) + { + ImRect r = Funcs::GetWindowRect(g.NavWindow, rect_n); + Text("(%6.1f,%6.1f) (%6.1f,%6.1f) Size (%6.1f,%6.1f) %s", r.Min.x, r.Min.y, r.Max.x, r.Max.y, r.GetWidth(), r.GetHeight(), wrt_rects_names[rect_n]); + } + Unindent(); + } + Checkbox("Show ImDrawCmd mesh when hovering", &cfg->ShowDrawCmdMesh); + Checkbox("Show ImDrawCmd bounding boxes when hovering", &cfg->ShowDrawCmdBoundingBoxes); + + Checkbox("Show tables rectangles", &cfg->ShowTablesRects); + SameLine(); + SetNextItemWidth(GetFontSize() * 12); + cfg->ShowTablesRects |= Combo("##show_table_rects_type", &cfg->ShowTablesRectsType, trt_rects_names, TRT_Count, TRT_Count); + if (cfg->ShowTablesRects && g.NavWindow != NULL) + { + for (int table_n = 0; table_n < g.Tables.GetMapSize(); table_n++) + { + ImGuiTable* table = g.Tables.TryGetMapData(table_n); + if (table == NULL || table->LastFrameActive < g.FrameCount - 1 || (table->OuterWindow != g.NavWindow && table->InnerWindow != g.NavWindow)) + continue; + + BulletText("Table 0x%08X (%d columns, in '%s')", table->ID, table->ColumnsCount, table->OuterWindow->Name); + if (IsItemHovered()) + GetForegroundDrawList()->AddRect(table->OuterRect.Min - ImVec2(1, 1), table->OuterRect.Max + ImVec2(1, 1), IM_COL32(255, 255, 0, 255), 0.0f, 0, 2.0f); + Indent(); + char buf[128]; + for (int rect_n = 0; rect_n < TRT_Count; rect_n++) + { + if (rect_n >= TRT_ColumnsRect) + { + if (rect_n != TRT_ColumnsRect && rect_n != TRT_ColumnsClipRect) + continue; + for (int column_n = 0; column_n < table->ColumnsCount; column_n++) + { + ImRect r = Funcs::GetTableRect(table, rect_n, column_n); + ImFormatString(buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf), "(%6.1f,%6.1f) (%6.1f,%6.1f) Size (%6.1f,%6.1f) Col %d %s", r.Min.x, r.Min.y, r.Max.x, r.Max.y, r.GetWidth(), r.GetHeight(), column_n, trt_rects_names[rect_n]); + Selectable(buf); + if (IsItemHovered()) + GetForegroundDrawList()->AddRect(r.Min - ImVec2(1, 1), r.Max + ImVec2(1, 1), IM_COL32(255, 255, 0, 255), 0.0f, 0, 2.0f); + } + } + else + { + ImRect r = Funcs::GetTableRect(table, rect_n, -1); + ImFormatString(buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf), "(%6.1f,%6.1f) (%6.1f,%6.1f) Size (%6.1f,%6.1f) %s", r.Min.x, r.Min.y, r.Max.x, r.Max.y, r.GetWidth(), r.GetHeight(), trt_rects_names[rect_n]); + Selectable(buf); + if (IsItemHovered()) + GetForegroundDrawList()->AddRect(r.Min - ImVec2(1, 1), r.Max + ImVec2(1, 1), IM_COL32(255, 255, 0, 255), 0.0f, 0, 2.0f); + } + } + Unindent(); + } + } + + TreePop(); + } + + // Windows + DebugNodeWindowsList(&g.Windows, "Windows"); + //DebugNodeWindowsList(&g.WindowsFocusOrder, "WindowsFocusOrder"); + + // DrawLists + int drawlist_count = 0; + for (int viewport_i = 0; viewport_i < g.Viewports.Size; viewport_i++) + drawlist_count += g.Viewports[viewport_i]->DrawDataBuilder.GetDrawListCount(); + if (TreeNode("DrawLists", "DrawLists (%d)", drawlist_count)) + { + for (int viewport_i = 0; viewport_i < g.Viewports.Size; viewport_i++) + { + ImGuiViewportP* viewport = g.Viewports[viewport_i]; + for (int layer_i = 0; layer_i < IM_ARRAYSIZE(viewport->DrawDataBuilder.Layers); layer_i++) + for (int draw_list_i = 0; draw_list_i < viewport->DrawDataBuilder.Layers[layer_i].Size; draw_list_i++) + DebugNodeDrawList(NULL, viewport->DrawDataBuilder.Layers[layer_i][draw_list_i], "DrawList"); + } + TreePop(); + } + + // Viewports + if (TreeNode("Viewports", "Viewports (%d)", g.Viewports.Size)) + { + Indent(GetTreeNodeToLabelSpacing()); + RenderViewportsThumbnails(); + Unindent(GetTreeNodeToLabelSpacing()); + for (int i = 0; i < g.Viewports.Size; i++) + DebugNodeViewport(g.Viewports[i]); + TreePop(); + } + + // Details for Popups + if (TreeNode("Popups", "Popups (%d)", g.OpenPopupStack.Size)) + { + for (int i = 0; i < g.OpenPopupStack.Size; i++) + { + ImGuiWindow* window = g.OpenPopupStack[i].Window; + BulletText("PopupID: %08x, Window: '%s'%s%s", g.OpenPopupStack[i].PopupId, window ? window->Name : "NULL", window && (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow) ? " ChildWindow" : "", window && (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildMenu) ? " ChildMenu" : ""); + } + TreePop(); + } + + // Details for TabBars + if (TreeNode("TabBars", "Tab Bars (%d)", g.TabBars.GetAliveCount())) + { + for (int n = 0; n < g.TabBars.GetMapSize(); n++) + if (ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar = g.TabBars.TryGetMapData(n)) + { + PushID(tab_bar); + DebugNodeTabBar(tab_bar, "TabBar"); + PopID(); + } + TreePop(); + } + + // Details for Tables + if (TreeNode("Tables", "Tables (%d)", g.Tables.GetAliveCount())) + { + for (int n = 0; n < g.Tables.GetMapSize(); n++) + if (ImGuiTable* table = g.Tables.TryGetMapData(n)) + DebugNodeTable(table); + TreePop(); + } + + // Details for Fonts +#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_DEMO_WINDOWS + ImFontAtlas* atlas = g.IO.Fonts; + if (TreeNode("Fonts", "Fonts (%d)", atlas->Fonts.Size)) + { + ShowFontAtlas(atlas); + TreePop(); + } +#endif + + // Details for Docking +#ifdef IMGUI_HAS_DOCK + if (TreeNode("Docking")) + { + TreePop(); + } +#endif // #ifdef IMGUI_HAS_DOCK + + // Settings + if (TreeNode("Settings")) + { + if (SmallButton("Clear")) + ClearIniSettings(); + SameLine(); + if (SmallButton("Save to memory")) + SaveIniSettingsToMemory(); + SameLine(); + if (SmallButton("Save to disk")) + SaveIniSettingsToDisk(g.IO.IniFilename); + SameLine(); + if (g.IO.IniFilename) + Text("\"%s\"", g.IO.IniFilename); + else + TextUnformatted(""); + Text("SettingsDirtyTimer %.2f", g.SettingsDirtyTimer); + if (TreeNode("SettingsHandlers", "Settings handlers: (%d)", g.SettingsHandlers.Size)) + { + for (int n = 0; n < g.SettingsHandlers.Size; n++) + BulletText("%s", g.SettingsHandlers[n].TypeName); + TreePop(); + } + if (TreeNode("SettingsWindows", "Settings packed data: Windows: %d bytes", g.SettingsWindows.size())) + { + for (ImGuiWindowSettings* settings = g.SettingsWindows.begin(); settings != NULL; settings = g.SettingsWindows.next_chunk(settings)) + DebugNodeWindowSettings(settings); + TreePop(); + } + + if (TreeNode("SettingsTables", "Settings packed data: Tables: %d bytes", g.SettingsTables.size())) + { + for (ImGuiTableSettings* settings = g.SettingsTables.begin(); settings != NULL; settings = g.SettingsTables.next_chunk(settings)) + DebugNodeTableSettings(settings); + TreePop(); + } + +#ifdef IMGUI_HAS_DOCK +#endif // #ifdef IMGUI_HAS_DOCK + + if (TreeNode("SettingsIniData", "Settings unpacked data (.ini): %d bytes", g.SettingsIniData.size())) + { + InputTextMultiline("##Ini", (char*)(void*)g.SettingsIniData.c_str(), g.SettingsIniData.Buf.Size, ImVec2(-FLT_MIN, GetTextLineHeight() * 20), ImGuiInputTextFlags_ReadOnly); + TreePop(); + } + TreePop(); + } + + // Misc Details + if (TreeNode("Internal state")) + { + const char* input_source_names[] = { "None", "Mouse", "Keyboard", "Gamepad", "Nav", "Clipboard" }; IM_ASSERT(IM_ARRAYSIZE(input_source_names) == ImGuiInputSource_COUNT); + + Text("WINDOWING"); + Indent(); + Text("HoveredWindow: '%s'", g.HoveredWindow ? g.HoveredWindow->Name : "NULL"); + Text("HoveredWindow->Root: '%s'", g.HoveredWindow ? g.HoveredWindow->RootWindow->Name : "NULL"); + Text("HoveredWindowUnderMovingWindow: '%s'", g.HoveredWindowUnderMovingWindow ? g.HoveredWindowUnderMovingWindow->Name : "NULL"); + Text("MovingWindow: '%s'", g.MovingWindow ? g.MovingWindow->Name : "NULL"); + Unindent(); + + Text("ITEMS"); + Indent(); + Text("ActiveId: 0x%08X/0x%08X (%.2f sec), AllowOverlap: %d, Source: %s", g.ActiveId, g.ActiveIdPreviousFrame, g.ActiveIdTimer, g.ActiveIdAllowOverlap, input_source_names[g.ActiveIdSource]); + Text("ActiveIdWindow: '%s'", g.ActiveIdWindow ? g.ActiveIdWindow->Name : "NULL"); + Text("ActiveIdUsing: Wheel: %d, NavDirMask: %X, NavInputMask: %X, KeyInputMask: %llX", g.ActiveIdUsingMouseWheel, g.ActiveIdUsingNavDirMask, g.ActiveIdUsingNavInputMask, g.ActiveIdUsingKeyInputMask); + Text("HoveredId: 0x%08X (%.2f sec), AllowOverlap: %d", g.HoveredIdPreviousFrame, g.HoveredIdTimer, g.HoveredIdAllowOverlap); // Not displaying g.HoveredId as it is update mid-frame + Text("DragDrop: %d, SourceId = 0x%08X, Payload \"%s\" (%d bytes)", g.DragDropActive, g.DragDropPayload.SourceId, g.DragDropPayload.DataType, g.DragDropPayload.DataSize); + Unindent(); + + Text("NAV,FOCUS"); + Indent(); + Text("NavWindow: '%s'", g.NavWindow ? g.NavWindow->Name : "NULL"); + Text("NavId: 0x%08X, NavLayer: %d", g.NavId, g.NavLayer); + Text("NavInputSource: %s", input_source_names[g.NavInputSource]); + Text("NavActive: %d, NavVisible: %d", g.IO.NavActive, g.IO.NavVisible); + Text("NavActivateId: 0x%08X, NavInputId: 0x%08X", g.NavActivateId, g.NavInputId); + Text("NavDisableHighlight: %d, NavDisableMouseHover: %d", g.NavDisableHighlight, g.NavDisableMouseHover); + Text("NavFocusScopeId = 0x%08X", g.NavFocusScopeId); + Text("NavWindowingTarget: '%s'", g.NavWindowingTarget ? g.NavWindowingTarget->Name : "NULL"); + Unindent(); + + TreePop(); + } + + // Overlay: Display windows Rectangles and Begin Order + if (cfg->ShowWindowsRects || cfg->ShowWindowsBeginOrder) + { + for (int n = 0; n < g.Windows.Size; n++) + { + ImGuiWindow* window = g.Windows[n]; + if (!window->WasActive) + continue; + ImDrawList* draw_list = GetForegroundDrawList(window); + if (cfg->ShowWindowsRects) + { + ImRect r = Funcs::GetWindowRect(window, cfg->ShowWindowsRectsType); + draw_list->AddRect(r.Min, r.Max, IM_COL32(255, 0, 128, 255)); + } + if (cfg->ShowWindowsBeginOrder && !(window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow)) + { + char buf[32]; + ImFormatString(buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf), "%d", window->BeginOrderWithinContext); + float font_size = GetFontSize(); + draw_list->AddRectFilled(window->Pos, window->Pos + ImVec2(font_size, font_size), IM_COL32(200, 100, 100, 255)); + draw_list->AddText(window->Pos, IM_COL32(255, 255, 255, 255), buf); + } + } + } + + // Overlay: Display Tables Rectangles + if (cfg->ShowTablesRects) + { + for (int table_n = 0; table_n < g.Tables.GetMapSize(); table_n++) + { + ImGuiTable* table = g.Tables.TryGetMapData(table_n); + if (table == NULL || table->LastFrameActive < g.FrameCount - 1) + continue; + ImDrawList* draw_list = GetForegroundDrawList(table->OuterWindow); + if (cfg->ShowTablesRectsType >= TRT_ColumnsRect) + { + for (int column_n = 0; column_n < table->ColumnsCount; column_n++) + { + ImRect r = Funcs::GetTableRect(table, cfg->ShowTablesRectsType, column_n); + ImU32 col = (table->HoveredColumnBody == column_n) ? IM_COL32(255, 255, 128, 255) : IM_COL32(255, 0, 128, 255); + float thickness = (table->HoveredColumnBody == column_n) ? 3.0f : 1.0f; + draw_list->AddRect(r.Min, r.Max, col, 0.0f, 0, thickness); + } + } + else + { + ImRect r = Funcs::GetTableRect(table, cfg->ShowTablesRectsType, -1); + draw_list->AddRect(r.Min, r.Max, IM_COL32(255, 0, 128, 255)); + } + } + } + +#ifdef IMGUI_HAS_DOCK + // Overlay: Display Docking info + if (show_docking_nodes && g.IO.KeyCtrl) + { + } +#endif // #ifdef IMGUI_HAS_DOCK + + End(); +} + +// [DEBUG] List fonts in a font atlas and display its texture +void ImGui::ShowFontAtlas(ImFontAtlas* atlas) +{ + for (int i = 0; i < atlas->Fonts.Size; i++) + { + ImFont* font = atlas->Fonts[i]; + PushID(font); + DebugNodeFont(font); + PopID(); + } + if (TreeNode("Atlas texture", "Atlas texture (%dx%d pixels)", atlas->TexWidth, atlas->TexHeight)) + { + ImVec4 tint_col = ImVec4(1.0f, 1.0f, 1.0f, 1.0f); + ImVec4 border_col = ImVec4(1.0f, 1.0f, 1.0f, 0.5f); + Image(atlas->TexID, ImVec2((float)atlas->TexWidth, (float)atlas->TexHeight), ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f), ImVec2(1.0f, 1.0f), tint_col, border_col); + TreePop(); + } +} + +// [DEBUG] Display contents of Columns +void ImGui::DebugNodeColumns(ImGuiOldColumns* columns) +{ + if (!TreeNode((void*)(uintptr_t)columns->ID, "Columns Id: 0x%08X, Count: %d, Flags: 0x%04X", columns->ID, columns->Count, columns->Flags)) + return; + BulletText("Width: %.1f (MinX: %.1f, MaxX: %.1f)", columns->OffMaxX - columns->OffMinX, columns->OffMinX, columns->OffMaxX); + for (int column_n = 0; column_n < columns->Columns.Size; column_n++) + BulletText("Column %02d: OffsetNorm %.3f (= %.1f px)", column_n, columns->Columns[column_n].OffsetNorm, GetColumnOffsetFromNorm(columns, columns->Columns[column_n].OffsetNorm)); + TreePop(); +} + +// [DEBUG] Display contents of ImDrawList +void ImGui::DebugNodeDrawList(ImGuiWindow* window, const ImDrawList* draw_list, const char* label) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiMetricsConfig* cfg = &g.DebugMetricsConfig; + int cmd_count = draw_list->CmdBuffer.Size; + if (cmd_count > 0 && draw_list->CmdBuffer.back().ElemCount == 0 && draw_list->CmdBuffer.back().UserCallback == NULL) + cmd_count--; + bool node_open = TreeNode(draw_list, "%s: '%s' %d vtx, %d indices, %d cmds", label, draw_list->_OwnerName ? draw_list->_OwnerName : "", draw_list->VtxBuffer.Size, draw_list->IdxBuffer.Size, cmd_count); + if (draw_list == GetWindowDrawList()) + { + SameLine(); + TextColored(ImVec4(1.0f, 0.4f, 0.4f, 1.0f), "CURRENTLY APPENDING"); // Can't display stats for active draw list! (we don't have the data double-buffered) + if (node_open) + TreePop(); + return; + } + + ImDrawList* fg_draw_list = GetForegroundDrawList(window); // Render additional visuals into the top-most draw list + if (window && IsItemHovered()) + fg_draw_list->AddRect(window->Pos, window->Pos + window->Size, IM_COL32(255, 255, 0, 255)); + if (!node_open) + return; + + if (window && !window->WasActive) + TextDisabled("Warning: owning Window is inactive. This DrawList is not being rendered!"); + + for (const ImDrawCmd* pcmd = draw_list->CmdBuffer.Data; pcmd < draw_list->CmdBuffer.Data + cmd_count; pcmd++) + { + if (pcmd->UserCallback) + { + BulletText("Callback %p, user_data %p", pcmd->UserCallback, pcmd->UserCallbackData); + continue; + } + + char buf[300]; + ImFormatString(buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf), "DrawCmd:%5d tris, Tex 0x%p, ClipRect (%4.0f,%4.0f)-(%4.0f,%4.0f)", + pcmd->ElemCount / 3, (void*)(intptr_t)pcmd->TextureId, + pcmd->ClipRect.x, pcmd->ClipRect.y, pcmd->ClipRect.z, pcmd->ClipRect.w); + bool pcmd_node_open = TreeNode((void*)(pcmd - draw_list->CmdBuffer.begin()), "%s", buf); + if (IsItemHovered() && (cfg->ShowDrawCmdMesh || cfg->ShowDrawCmdBoundingBoxes) && fg_draw_list) + DebugNodeDrawCmdShowMeshAndBoundingBox(fg_draw_list, draw_list, pcmd, cfg->ShowDrawCmdMesh, cfg->ShowDrawCmdBoundingBoxes); + if (!pcmd_node_open) + continue; + + // Calculate approximate coverage area (touched pixel count) + // This will be in pixels squared as long there's no post-scaling happening to the renderer output. + const ImDrawIdx* idx_buffer = (draw_list->IdxBuffer.Size > 0) ? draw_list->IdxBuffer.Data : NULL; + const ImDrawVert* vtx_buffer = draw_list->VtxBuffer.Data + pcmd->VtxOffset; + float total_area = 0.0f; + for (unsigned int idx_n = pcmd->IdxOffset; idx_n < pcmd->IdxOffset + pcmd->ElemCount; ) + { + ImVec2 triangle[3]; + for (int n = 0; n < 3; n++, idx_n++) + triangle[n] = vtx_buffer[idx_buffer ? idx_buffer[idx_n] : idx_n].pos; + total_area += ImTriangleArea(triangle[0], triangle[1], triangle[2]); + } + + // Display vertex information summary. Hover to get all triangles drawn in wire-frame + ImFormatString(buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf), "Mesh: ElemCount: %d, VtxOffset: +%d, IdxOffset: +%d, Area: ~%0.f px", pcmd->ElemCount, pcmd->VtxOffset, pcmd->IdxOffset, total_area); + Selectable(buf); + if (IsItemHovered() && fg_draw_list) + DebugNodeDrawCmdShowMeshAndBoundingBox(fg_draw_list, draw_list, pcmd, true, false); + + // Display individual triangles/vertices. Hover on to get the corresponding triangle highlighted. + ImGuiListClipper clipper; + clipper.Begin(pcmd->ElemCount / 3); // Manually coarse clip our print out of individual vertices to save CPU, only items that may be visible. + while (clipper.Step()) + for (int prim = clipper.DisplayStart, idx_i = pcmd->IdxOffset + clipper.DisplayStart * 3; prim < clipper.DisplayEnd; prim++) + { + char* buf_p = buf, * buf_end = buf + IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf); + ImVec2 triangle[3]; + for (int n = 0; n < 3; n++, idx_i++) + { + const ImDrawVert& v = vtx_buffer[idx_buffer ? idx_buffer[idx_i] : idx_i]; + triangle[n] = v.pos; + buf_p += ImFormatString(buf_p, buf_end - buf_p, "%s %04d: pos (%8.2f,%8.2f), uv (%.6f,%.6f), col %08X\n", + (n == 0) ? "Vert:" : " ", idx_i, v.pos.x, v.pos.y, v.uv.x, v.uv.y, v.col); + } + + Selectable(buf, false); + if (fg_draw_list && IsItemHovered()) + { + ImDrawListFlags backup_flags = fg_draw_list->Flags; + fg_draw_list->Flags &= ~ImDrawListFlags_AntiAliasedLines; // Disable AA on triangle outlines is more readable for very large and thin triangles. + fg_draw_list->AddPolyline(triangle, 3, IM_COL32(255, 255, 0, 255), ImDrawFlags_Closed, 1.0f); + fg_draw_list->Flags = backup_flags; + } + } + TreePop(); + } + TreePop(); +} + +// [DEBUG] Display mesh/aabb of a ImDrawCmd +void ImGui::DebugNodeDrawCmdShowMeshAndBoundingBox(ImDrawList* out_draw_list, const ImDrawList* draw_list, const ImDrawCmd* draw_cmd, bool show_mesh, bool show_aabb) +{ + IM_ASSERT(show_mesh || show_aabb); + + // Draw wire-frame version of all triangles + ImRect clip_rect = draw_cmd->ClipRect; + ImRect vtxs_rect(FLT_MAX, FLT_MAX, -FLT_MAX, -FLT_MAX); + ImDrawListFlags backup_flags = out_draw_list->Flags; + out_draw_list->Flags &= ~ImDrawListFlags_AntiAliasedLines; // Disable AA on triangle outlines is more readable for very large and thin triangles. + for (unsigned int idx_n = draw_cmd->IdxOffset, idx_end = draw_cmd->IdxOffset + draw_cmd->ElemCount; idx_n < idx_end; ) + { + ImDrawIdx* idx_buffer = (draw_list->IdxBuffer.Size > 0) ? draw_list->IdxBuffer.Data : NULL; // We don't hold on those pointers past iterations as ->AddPolyline() may invalidate them if out_draw_list==draw_list + ImDrawVert* vtx_buffer = draw_list->VtxBuffer.Data + draw_cmd->VtxOffset; + + ImVec2 triangle[3]; + for (int n = 0; n < 3; n++, idx_n++) + vtxs_rect.Add((triangle[n] = vtx_buffer[idx_buffer ? idx_buffer[idx_n] : idx_n].pos)); + if (show_mesh) + out_draw_list->AddPolyline(triangle, 3, IM_COL32(255, 255, 0, 255), ImDrawFlags_Closed, 1.0f); // In yellow: mesh triangles + } + // Draw bounding boxes + if (show_aabb) + { + out_draw_list->AddRect(ImFloor(clip_rect.Min), ImFloor(clip_rect.Max), IM_COL32(255, 0, 255, 255)); // In pink: clipping rectangle submitted to GPU + out_draw_list->AddRect(ImFloor(vtxs_rect.Min), ImFloor(vtxs_rect.Max), IM_COL32(0, 255, 255, 255)); // In cyan: bounding box of triangles + } + out_draw_list->Flags = backup_flags; +} + +// [DEBUG] Display details for a single font, called by ShowStyleEditor(). +void ImGui::DebugNodeFont(ImFont* font) +{ + bool opened = TreeNode(font, "Font: \"%s\"\n%.2f px, %d glyphs, %d file(s)", + font->ConfigData ? font->ConfigData[0].Name : "", font->FontSize, font->Glyphs.Size, font->ConfigDataCount); + SameLine(); + if (SmallButton("Set as default")) + GetIO().FontDefault = font; + if (!opened) + return; + + // Display preview text + PushFont(font); + Text("The quick brown fox jumps over the lazy dog"); + PopFont(); + + // Display details + SetNextItemWidth(GetFontSize() * 8); + DragFloat("Font scale", &font->Scale, 0.005f, 0.3f, 2.0f, "%.1f"); + SameLine(); MetricsHelpMarker( + "Note than the default embedded font is NOT meant to be scaled.\n\n" + "Font are currently rendered into bitmaps at a given size at the time of building the atlas. " + "You may oversample them to get some flexibility with scaling. " + "You can also render at multiple sizes and select which one to use at runtime.\n\n" + "(Glimmer of hope: the atlas system will be rewritten in the future to make scaling more flexible.)"); + Text("Ascent: %f, Descent: %f, Height: %f", font->Ascent, font->Descent, font->Ascent - font->Descent); + char c_str[5]; + Text("Fallback character: '%s' (U+%04X)", ImTextCharToUtf8(c_str, font->FallbackChar), font->FallbackChar); + Text("Ellipsis character: '%s' (U+%04X)", ImTextCharToUtf8(c_str, font->EllipsisChar), font->EllipsisChar); + const int surface_sqrt = (int)ImSqrt((float)font->MetricsTotalSurface); + Text("Texture Area: about %d px ~%dx%d px", font->MetricsTotalSurface, surface_sqrt, surface_sqrt); + for (int config_i = 0; config_i < font->ConfigDataCount; config_i++) + if (font->ConfigData) + if (const ImFontConfig* cfg = &font->ConfigData[config_i]) + BulletText("Input %d: \'%s\', Oversample: (%d,%d), PixelSnapH: %d, Offset: (%.1f,%.1f)", + config_i, cfg->Name, cfg->OversampleH, cfg->OversampleV, cfg->PixelSnapH, cfg->GlyphOffset.x, cfg->GlyphOffset.y); + + // Display all glyphs of the fonts in separate pages of 256 characters + if (TreeNode("Glyphs", "Glyphs (%d)", font->Glyphs.Size)) + { + ImDrawList* draw_list = GetWindowDrawList(); + const ImU32 glyph_col = GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text); + const float cell_size = font->FontSize * 1; + const float cell_spacing = GetStyle().ItemSpacing.y; + for (unsigned int base = 0; base <= IM_UNICODE_CODEPOINT_MAX; base += 256) + { + // Skip ahead if a large bunch of glyphs are not present in the font (test in chunks of 4k) + // This is only a small optimization to reduce the number of iterations when IM_UNICODE_MAX_CODEPOINT + // is large // (if ImWchar==ImWchar32 we will do at least about 272 queries here) + if (!(base & 4095) && font->IsGlyphRangeUnused(base, base + 4095)) + { + base += 4096 - 256; + continue; + } + + int count = 0; + for (unsigned int n = 0; n < 256; n++) + if (font->FindGlyphNoFallback((ImWchar)(base + n))) + count++; + if (count <= 0) + continue; + if (!TreeNode((void*)(intptr_t)base, "U+%04X..U+%04X (%d %s)", base, base + 255, count, count > 1 ? "glyphs" : "glyph")) + continue; + + // Draw a 16x16 grid of glyphs + ImVec2 base_pos = GetCursorScreenPos(); + for (unsigned int n = 0; n < 256; n++) + { + // We use ImFont::RenderChar as a shortcut because we don't have UTF-8 conversion functions + // available here and thus cannot easily generate a zero-terminated UTF-8 encoded string. + ImVec2 cell_p1(base_pos.x + (n % 16) * (cell_size + cell_spacing), base_pos.y + (n / 16) * (cell_size + cell_spacing)); + ImVec2 cell_p2(cell_p1.x + cell_size, cell_p1.y + cell_size); + const ImFontGlyph* glyph = font->FindGlyphNoFallback((ImWchar)(base + n)); + draw_list->AddRect(cell_p1, cell_p2, glyph ? IM_COL32(255, 255, 255, 100) : IM_COL32(255, 255, 255, 50)); + if (glyph) + font->RenderChar(draw_list, cell_size, cell_p1, glyph_col, (ImWchar)(base + n)); + if (glyph && IsMouseHoveringRect(cell_p1, cell_p2)) + { + BeginTooltip(); + Text("Codepoint: U+%04X", base + n); + Separator(); + Text("Visible: %d", glyph->Visible); + Text("AdvanceX: %.1f", glyph->AdvanceX); + Text("Pos: (%.2f,%.2f)->(%.2f,%.2f)", glyph->X0, glyph->Y0, glyph->X1, glyph->Y1); + Text("UV: (%.3f,%.3f)->(%.3f,%.3f)", glyph->U0, glyph->V0, glyph->U1, glyph->V1); + EndTooltip(); + } + } + Dummy(ImVec2((cell_size + cell_spacing) * 16, (cell_size + cell_spacing) * 16)); + TreePop(); + } + TreePop(); + } + TreePop(); +} + +// [DEBUG] Display contents of ImGuiStorage +void ImGui::DebugNodeStorage(ImGuiStorage* storage, const char* label) +{ + if (!TreeNode(label, "%s: %d entries, %d bytes", label, storage->Data.Size, storage->Data.size_in_bytes())) + return; + for (int n = 0; n < storage->Data.Size; n++) + { + const ImGuiStorage::ImGuiStoragePair& p = storage->Data[n]; + BulletText("Key 0x%08X Value { i: %d }", p.key, p.val_i); // Important: we currently don't store a type, real value may not be integer. + } + TreePop(); +} + +// [DEBUG] Display contents of ImGuiTabBar +void ImGui::DebugNodeTabBar(ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar, const char* label) +{ + // Standalone tab bars (not associated to docking/windows functionality) currently hold no discernible strings. + char buf[256]; + char* p = buf; + const char* buf_end = buf + IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf); + const bool is_active = (tab_bar->PrevFrameVisible >= GetFrameCount() - 2); + p += ImFormatString(p, buf_end - p, "%s 0x%08X (%d tabs)%s", label, tab_bar->ID, tab_bar->Tabs.Size, is_active ? "" : " *Inactive*"); + p += ImFormatString(p, buf_end - p, " { "); + for (int tab_n = 0; tab_n < ImMin(tab_bar->Tabs.Size, 3); tab_n++) + { + ImGuiTabItem* tab = &tab_bar->Tabs[tab_n]; + p += ImFormatString(p, buf_end - p, "%s'%s'", + tab_n > 0 ? ", " : "", (tab->NameOffset != -1) ? tab_bar->GetTabName(tab) : "???"); + } + p += ImFormatString(p, buf_end - p, (tab_bar->Tabs.Size > 3) ? " ... }" : " } "); + if (!is_active) { PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_Text, GetStyleColorVec4(ImGuiCol_TextDisabled)); } + bool open = TreeNode(label, "%s", buf); + if (!is_active) { PopStyleColor(); } + if (is_active && IsItemHovered()) + { + ImDrawList* draw_list = GetForegroundDrawList(); + draw_list->AddRect(tab_bar->BarRect.Min, tab_bar->BarRect.Max, IM_COL32(255, 255, 0, 255)); + draw_list->AddLine(ImVec2(tab_bar->ScrollingRectMinX, tab_bar->BarRect.Min.y), ImVec2(tab_bar->ScrollingRectMinX, tab_bar->BarRect.Max.y), IM_COL32(0, 255, 0, 255)); + draw_list->AddLine(ImVec2(tab_bar->ScrollingRectMaxX, tab_bar->BarRect.Min.y), ImVec2(tab_bar->ScrollingRectMaxX, tab_bar->BarRect.Max.y), IM_COL32(0, 255, 0, 255)); + } + if (open) + { + for (int tab_n = 0; tab_n < tab_bar->Tabs.Size; tab_n++) + { + const ImGuiTabItem* tab = &tab_bar->Tabs[tab_n]; + PushID(tab); + if (SmallButton("<")) { TabBarQueueReorder(tab_bar, tab, -1); } SameLine(0, 2); + if (SmallButton(">")) { TabBarQueueReorder(tab_bar, tab, +1); } SameLine(); + Text("%02d%c Tab 0x%08X '%s' Offset: %.1f, Width: %.1f/%.1f", + tab_n, (tab->ID == tab_bar->SelectedTabId) ? '*' : ' ', tab->ID, (tab->NameOffset != -1) ? tab_bar->GetTabName(tab) : "???", tab->Offset, tab->Width, tab->ContentWidth); + PopID(); + } + TreePop(); + } +} + +void ImGui::DebugNodeViewport(ImGuiViewportP* viewport) +{ + SetNextItemOpen(true, ImGuiCond_Once); + if (TreeNode("viewport0", "Viewport #%d", 0)) + { + ImGuiWindowFlags flags = viewport->Flags; + BulletText("Main Pos: (%.0f,%.0f), Size: (%.0f,%.0f)\nWorkArea Offset Left: %.0f Top: %.0f, Right: %.0f, Bottom: %.0f", + viewport->Pos.x, viewport->Pos.y, viewport->Size.x, viewport->Size.y, + viewport->WorkOffsetMin.x, viewport->WorkOffsetMin.y, viewport->WorkOffsetMax.x, viewport->WorkOffsetMax.y); + BulletText("Flags: 0x%04X =%s%s%s", viewport->Flags, + (flags & ImGuiViewportFlags_IsPlatformWindow) ? " IsPlatformWindow" : "", + (flags & ImGuiViewportFlags_IsPlatformMonitor) ? " IsPlatformMonitor" : "", + (flags & ImGuiViewportFlags_OwnedByApp) ? " OwnedByApp" : ""); + for (int layer_i = 0; layer_i < IM_ARRAYSIZE(viewport->DrawDataBuilder.Layers); layer_i++) + for (int draw_list_i = 0; draw_list_i < viewport->DrawDataBuilder.Layers[layer_i].Size; draw_list_i++) + DebugNodeDrawList(NULL, viewport->DrawDataBuilder.Layers[layer_i][draw_list_i], "DrawList"); + TreePop(); + } +} + +void ImGui::DebugNodeWindow(ImGuiWindow* window, const char* label) +{ + if (window == NULL) + { + BulletText("%s: NULL", label); + return; + } + + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + const bool is_active = window->WasActive; + ImGuiTreeNodeFlags tree_node_flags = (window == g.NavWindow) ? ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Selected : ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_None; + if (!is_active) { PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_Text, GetStyleColorVec4(ImGuiCol_TextDisabled)); } + const bool open = TreeNodeEx(label, tree_node_flags, "%s '%s'%s", label, window->Name, is_active ? "" : " *Inactive*"); + if (!is_active) { PopStyleColor(); } + if (IsItemHovered() && is_active) + GetForegroundDrawList(window)->AddRect(window->Pos, window->Pos + window->Size, IM_COL32(255, 255, 0, 255)); + if (!open) + return; + + if (window->MemoryCompacted) + TextDisabled("Note: some memory buffers have been compacted/freed."); + + ImGuiWindowFlags flags = window->Flags; + DebugNodeDrawList(window, window->DrawList, "DrawList"); + BulletText("Pos: (%.1f,%.1f), Size: (%.1f,%.1f), ContentSize (%.1f,%.1f) Ideal (%.1f,%.1f)", window->Pos.x, window->Pos.y, window->Size.x, window->Size.y, window->ContentSize.x, window->ContentSize.y, window->ContentSizeIdeal.x, window->ContentSizeIdeal.y); + BulletText("Flags: 0x%08X (%s%s%s%s%s%s%s%s%s..)", flags, + (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow) ? "Child " : "", (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Tooltip) ? "Tooltip " : "", (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup) ? "Popup " : "", + (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Modal) ? "Modal " : "", (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildMenu) ? "ChildMenu " : "", (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoSavedSettings) ? "NoSavedSettings " : "", + (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoMouseInputs)? "NoMouseInputs":"", (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoNavInputs) ? "NoNavInputs" : "", (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize) ? "AlwaysAutoResize" : ""); + BulletText("Scroll: (%.2f/%.2f,%.2f/%.2f) Scrollbar:%s%s", window->Scroll.x, window->ScrollMax.x, window->Scroll.y, window->ScrollMax.y, window->ScrollbarX ? "X" : "", window->ScrollbarY ? "Y" : ""); + BulletText("Active: %d/%d, WriteAccessed: %d, BeginOrderWithinContext: %d", window->Active, window->WasActive, window->WriteAccessed, (window->Active || window->WasActive) ? window->BeginOrderWithinContext : -1); + BulletText("Appearing: %d, Hidden: %d (CanSkip %d Cannot %d), SkipItems: %d", window->Appearing, window->Hidden, window->HiddenFramesCanSkipItems, window->HiddenFramesCannotSkipItems, window->SkipItems); + for (int layer = 0; layer < ImGuiNavLayer_COUNT; layer++) + { + ImRect r = window->NavRectRel[layer]; + if (r.Min.x >= r.Max.y && r.Min.y >= r.Max.y) + { + BulletText("NavLastIds[%d]: 0x%08X", layer, window->NavLastIds[layer]); + continue; + } + BulletText("NavLastIds[%d]: 0x%08X at +(%.1f,%.1f)(%.1f,%.1f)", layer, window->NavLastIds[layer], r.Min.x, r.Min.y, r.Max.x, r.Max.y); + if (IsItemHovered()) + GetForegroundDrawList(window)->AddRect(r.Min + window->Pos, r.Max + window->Pos, IM_COL32(255, 255, 0, 255)); + } + BulletText("NavLayersActiveMask: %X, NavLastChildNavWindow: %s", window->DC.NavLayersActiveMask, window->NavLastChildNavWindow ? window->NavLastChildNavWindow->Name : "NULL"); + if (window->RootWindow != window) { DebugNodeWindow(window->RootWindow, "RootWindow"); } + if (window->ParentWindow != NULL) { DebugNodeWindow(window->ParentWindow, "ParentWindow"); } + if (window->DC.ChildWindows.Size > 0) { DebugNodeWindowsList(&window->DC.ChildWindows, "ChildWindows"); } + if (window->ColumnsStorage.Size > 0 && TreeNode("Columns", "Columns sets (%d)", window->ColumnsStorage.Size)) + { + for (int n = 0; n < window->ColumnsStorage.Size; n++) + DebugNodeColumns(&window->ColumnsStorage[n]); + TreePop(); + } + DebugNodeStorage(&window->StateStorage, "Storage"); + TreePop(); +} + +void ImGui::DebugNodeWindowSettings(ImGuiWindowSettings* settings) +{ + Text("0x%08X \"%s\" Pos (%d,%d) Size (%d,%d) Collapsed=%d", + settings->ID, settings->GetName(), settings->Pos.x, settings->Pos.y, settings->Size.x, settings->Size.y, settings->Collapsed); +} + +void ImGui::DebugNodeWindowsList(ImVector* windows, const char* label) +{ + if (!TreeNode(label, "%s (%d)", label, windows->Size)) + return; + Text("(In front-to-back order:)"); + for (int i = windows->Size - 1; i >= 0; i--) // Iterate front to back + { + PushID((*windows)[i]); + DebugNodeWindow((*windows)[i], "Window"); + PopID(); + } + TreePop(); +} + +#else + +void ImGui::ShowMetricsWindow(bool*) {} +void ImGui::ShowFontAtlas(ImFontAtlas*) {} +void ImGui::DebugNodeColumns(ImGuiOldColumns*) {} +void ImGui::DebugNodeDrawList(ImGuiWindow*, const ImDrawList*, const char*) {} +void ImGui::DebugNodeDrawCmdShowMeshAndBoundingBox(ImDrawList*, const ImDrawList*, const ImDrawCmd*, bool, bool) {} +void ImGui::DebugNodeFont(ImFont*) {} +void ImGui::DebugNodeStorage(ImGuiStorage*, const char*) {} +void ImGui::DebugNodeTabBar(ImGuiTabBar*, const char*) {} +void ImGui::DebugNodeWindow(ImGuiWindow*, const char*) {} +void ImGui::DebugNodeWindowSettings(ImGuiWindowSettings*) {} +void ImGui::DebugNodeWindowsList(ImVector*, const char*) {} +void ImGui::DebugNodeViewport(ImGuiViewportP*) {} + +#endif + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// Include imgui_user.inl at the end of imgui.cpp to access private data/functions that aren't exposed. +// Prefer just including imgui_internal.h from your code rather than using this define. If a declaration is missing from imgui_internal.h add it or request it on the github. +#ifdef IMGUI_INCLUDE_IMGUI_USER_INL +#include "imgui_user.inl" +#endif + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +#endif // #ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE diff --git a/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/imgui-1.84.2/imgui.h b/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/imgui-1.84.2/imgui.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000..b56cb85 --- /dev/null +++ b/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/imgui-1.84.2/imgui.h @@ -0,0 +1,2897 @@ +// dear imgui, v1.84 +// (headers) + +// Help: +// - Read FAQ at http://dearimgui.org/faq +// - Newcomers, read 'Programmer guide' in imgui.cpp for notes on how to setup Dear ImGui in your codebase. +// - Call and read ImGui::ShowDemoWindow() in imgui_demo.cpp. All applications in examples/ are doing that. +// Read imgui.cpp for details, links and comments. + +// Resources: +// - FAQ http://dearimgui.org/faq +// - Homepage & latest https://github.com/ocornut/imgui +// - Releases & changelog https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/releases +// - Gallery https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/issues/4451 (please post your screenshots/video there!) +// - Wiki https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/wiki (lots of good stuff there) +// - Glossary https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/wiki/Glossary +// - Issues & support https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/issues +// - Discussions https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/discussions + +/* + +Index of this file: +// [SECTION] Header mess +// [SECTION] Forward declarations and basic types +// [SECTION] Dear ImGui end-user API functions +// [SECTION] Flags & Enumerations +// [SECTION] Helpers: Memory allocations macros, ImVector<> +// [SECTION] ImGuiStyle +// [SECTION] ImGuiIO +// [SECTION] Misc data structures (ImGuiInputTextCallbackData, ImGuiSizeCallbackData, ImGuiPayload, ImGuiTableSortSpecs, ImGuiTableColumnSortSpecs) +// [SECTION] Helpers (ImGuiOnceUponAFrame, ImGuiTextFilter, ImGuiTextBuffer, ImGuiStorage, ImGuiListClipper, ImColor) +// [SECTION] Drawing API (ImDrawCallback, ImDrawCmd, ImDrawIdx, ImDrawVert, ImDrawChannel, ImDrawListSplitter, ImDrawFlags, ImDrawListFlags, ImDrawList, ImDrawData) +// [SECTION] Font API (ImFontConfig, ImFontGlyph, ImFontGlyphRangesBuilder, ImFontAtlasFlags, ImFontAtlas, ImFont) +// [SECTION] Viewports (ImGuiViewportFlags, ImGuiViewport) +// [SECTION] Obsolete functions and types + +*/ + +#pragma once + +// Configuration file with compile-time options (edit imconfig.h or '#define IMGUI_USER_CONFIG "myfilename.h" from your build system') +#ifdef IMGUI_USER_CONFIG +#include IMGUI_USER_CONFIG +#endif +#if !defined(IMGUI_DISABLE_INCLUDE_IMCONFIG_H) || defined(IMGUI_INCLUDE_IMCONFIG_H) +#include "imconfig.h" +#endif + +#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Header mess +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// Includes +#include // FLT_MIN, FLT_MAX +#include // va_list, va_start, va_end +#include // ptrdiff_t, NULL +#include // memset, memmove, memcpy, strlen, strchr, strcpy, strcmp + +// Version +// (Integer encoded as XYYZZ for use in #if preprocessor conditionals. Work in progress versions typically starts at XYY99 then bounce up to XYY00, XYY01 etc. when release tagging happens) +#define IMGUI_VERSION "1.84.2" +#define IMGUI_VERSION_NUM 18405 +#define IMGUI_CHECKVERSION() ImGui::DebugCheckVersionAndDataLayout(IMGUI_VERSION, sizeof(ImGuiIO), sizeof(ImGuiStyle), sizeof(ImVec2), sizeof(ImVec4), sizeof(ImDrawVert), sizeof(ImDrawIdx)) +#define IMGUI_HAS_TABLE + +// Define attributes of all API symbols declarations (e.g. for DLL under Windows) +// IMGUI_API is used for core imgui functions, IMGUI_IMPL_API is used for the default backends files (imgui_impl_xxx.h) +// Using dear imgui via a shared library is not recommended, because we don't guarantee backward nor forward ABI compatibility (also function call overhead, as dear imgui is a call-heavy API) +#ifndef IMGUI_API +#define IMGUI_API +#endif +#ifndef IMGUI_IMPL_API +#define IMGUI_IMPL_API IMGUI_API +#endif + +// Helper Macros +#ifndef IM_ASSERT +#include +#define IM_ASSERT(_EXPR) assert(_EXPR) // You can override the default assert handler by editing imconfig.h +#endif +#define IM_ARRAYSIZE(_ARR) ((int)(sizeof(_ARR) / sizeof(*(_ARR)))) // Size of a static C-style array. Don't use on pointers! +#define IM_UNUSED(_VAR) ((void)(_VAR)) // Used to silence "unused variable warnings". Often useful as asserts may be stripped out from final builds. +#if (__cplusplus >= 201100) || (defined(_MSVC_LANG) && _MSVC_LANG >= 201100) +#define IM_OFFSETOF(_TYPE,_MEMBER) offsetof(_TYPE, _MEMBER) // Offset of _MEMBER within _TYPE. Standardized as offsetof() in C++11 +#else +#define IM_OFFSETOF(_TYPE,_MEMBER) ((size_t)&(((_TYPE*)0)->_MEMBER)) // Offset of _MEMBER within _TYPE. Old style macro. +#endif + +// Helper Macros - IM_FMTARGS, IM_FMTLIST: Apply printf-style warnings to our formatting functions. +#if !defined(IMGUI_USE_STB_SPRINTF) && defined(__MINGW32__) +#define IM_FMTARGS(FMT) __attribute__((format(gnu_printf, FMT, FMT+1))) +#define IM_FMTLIST(FMT) __attribute__((format(gnu_printf, FMT, 0))) +#elif !defined(IMGUI_USE_STB_SPRINTF) && (defined(__clang__) || defined(__GNUC__)) +#define IM_FMTARGS(FMT) __attribute__((format(printf, FMT, FMT+1))) +#define IM_FMTLIST(FMT) __attribute__((format(printf, FMT, 0))) +#else +#define IM_FMTARGS(FMT) +#define IM_FMTLIST(FMT) +#endif + +// Disable some of MSVC most aggressive Debug runtime checks in function header/footer (used in some simple/low-level functions) +#if defined(_MSC_VER) && !defined(__clang__) && !defined(IMGUI_DEBUG_PARANOID) +#define IM_MSVC_RUNTIME_CHECKS_OFF __pragma(runtime_checks("",off)) __pragma(check_stack(off)) __pragma(strict_gs_check(push,off)) +#define IM_MSVC_RUNTIME_CHECKS_RESTORE __pragma(runtime_checks("",restore)) __pragma(check_stack()) __pragma(strict_gs_check(pop)) +#else +#define IM_MSVC_RUNTIME_CHECKS_OFF +#define IM_MSVC_RUNTIME_CHECKS_RESTORE +#endif + +// Warnings +#ifdef _MSC_VER +#pragma warning (push) +#pragma warning (disable: 26495) // [Static Analyzer] Variable 'XXX' is uninitialized. Always initialize a member variable (type.6). +#endif +#if defined(__clang__) +#pragma clang diagnostic push +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wold-style-cast" +#if __has_warning("-Wzero-as-null-pointer-constant") +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wzero-as-null-pointer-constant" +#endif +#elif defined(__GNUC__) +#pragma GCC diagnostic push +#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wpragmas" // warning: unknown option after '#pragma GCC diagnostic' kind +#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wclass-memaccess" // [__GNUC__ >= 8] warning: 'memset/memcpy' clearing/writing an object of type 'xxxx' with no trivial copy-assignment; use assignment or value-initialization instead +#endif + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Forward declarations and basic types +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// Forward declarations +struct ImDrawChannel; // Temporary storage to output draw commands out of order, used by ImDrawListSplitter and ImDrawList::ChannelsSplit() +struct ImDrawCmd; // A single draw command within a parent ImDrawList (generally maps to 1 GPU draw call, unless it is a callback) +struct ImDrawData; // All draw command lists required to render the frame + pos/size coordinates to use for the projection matrix. +struct ImDrawList; // A single draw command list (generally one per window, conceptually you may see this as a dynamic "mesh" builder) +struct ImDrawListSharedData; // Data shared among multiple draw lists (typically owned by parent ImGui context, but you may create one yourself) +struct ImDrawListSplitter; // Helper to split a draw list into different layers which can be drawn into out of order, then flattened back. +struct ImDrawVert; // A single vertex (pos + uv + col = 20 bytes by default. Override layout with IMGUI_OVERRIDE_DRAWVERT_STRUCT_LAYOUT) +struct ImFont; // Runtime data for a single font within a parent ImFontAtlas +struct ImFontAtlas; // Runtime data for multiple fonts, bake multiple fonts into a single texture, TTF/OTF font loader +struct ImFontBuilderIO; // Opaque interface to a font builder (stb_truetype or FreeType). +struct ImFontConfig; // Configuration data when adding a font or merging fonts +struct ImFontGlyph; // A single font glyph (code point + coordinates within in ImFontAtlas + offset) +struct ImFontGlyphRangesBuilder; // Helper to build glyph ranges from text/string data +struct ImColor; // Helper functions to create a color that can be converted to either u32 or float4 (*OBSOLETE* please avoid using) +struct ImGuiContext; // Dear ImGui context (opaque structure, unless including imgui_internal.h) +struct ImGuiIO; // Main configuration and I/O between your application and ImGui +struct ImGuiInputTextCallbackData; // Shared state of InputText() when using custom ImGuiInputTextCallback (rare/advanced use) +struct ImGuiListClipper; // Helper to manually clip large list of items +struct ImGuiOnceUponAFrame; // Helper for running a block of code not more than once a frame, used by IMGUI_ONCE_UPON_A_FRAME macro +struct ImGuiPayload; // User data payload for drag and drop operations +struct ImGuiSizeCallbackData; // Callback data when using SetNextWindowSizeConstraints() (rare/advanced use) +struct ImGuiStorage; // Helper for key->value storage +struct ImGuiStyle; // Runtime data for styling/colors +struct ImGuiTableSortSpecs; // Sorting specifications for a table (often handling sort specs for a single column, occasionally more) +struct ImGuiTableColumnSortSpecs; // Sorting specification for one column of a table +struct ImGuiTextBuffer; // Helper to hold and append into a text buffer (~string builder) +struct ImGuiTextFilter; // Helper to parse and apply text filters (e.g. "aaaaa[,bbbbb][,ccccc]") +struct ImGuiViewport; // A Platform Window (always only one in 'master' branch), in the future may represent Platform Monitor + +// Enums/Flags (declared as int for compatibility with old C++, to allow using as flags without overhead, and to not pollute the top of this file) +// - Tip: Use your programming IDE navigation facilities on the names in the _central column_ below to find the actual flags/enum lists! +// In Visual Studio IDE: CTRL+comma ("Edit.NavigateTo") can follow symbols in comments, whereas CTRL+F12 ("Edit.GoToImplementation") cannot. +// With Visual Assist installed: ALT+G ("VAssistX.GoToImplementation") can also follow symbols in comments. +typedef int ImGuiCol; // -> enum ImGuiCol_ // Enum: A color identifier for styling +typedef int ImGuiCond; // -> enum ImGuiCond_ // Enum: A condition for many Set*() functions +typedef int ImGuiDataType; // -> enum ImGuiDataType_ // Enum: A primary data type +typedef int ImGuiDir; // -> enum ImGuiDir_ // Enum: A cardinal direction +typedef int ImGuiKey; // -> enum ImGuiKey_ // Enum: A key identifier (ImGui-side enum) +typedef int ImGuiNavInput; // -> enum ImGuiNavInput_ // Enum: An input identifier for navigation +typedef int ImGuiMouseButton; // -> enum ImGuiMouseButton_ // Enum: A mouse button identifier (0=left, 1=right, 2=middle) +typedef int ImGuiMouseCursor; // -> enum ImGuiMouseCursor_ // Enum: A mouse cursor identifier +typedef int ImGuiSortDirection; // -> enum ImGuiSortDirection_ // Enum: A sorting direction (ascending or descending) +typedef int ImGuiStyleVar; // -> enum ImGuiStyleVar_ // Enum: A variable identifier for styling +typedef int ImGuiTableBgTarget; // -> enum ImGuiTableBgTarget_ // Enum: A color target for TableSetBgColor() +typedef int ImDrawFlags; // -> enum ImDrawFlags_ // Flags: for ImDrawList functions +typedef int ImDrawListFlags; // -> enum ImDrawListFlags_ // Flags: for ImDrawList instance +typedef int ImFontAtlasFlags; // -> enum ImFontAtlasFlags_ // Flags: for ImFontAtlas build +typedef int ImGuiBackendFlags; // -> enum ImGuiBackendFlags_ // Flags: for io.BackendFlags +typedef int ImGuiButtonFlags; // -> enum ImGuiButtonFlags_ // Flags: for InvisibleButton() +typedef int ImGuiColorEditFlags; // -> enum ImGuiColorEditFlags_ // Flags: for ColorEdit4(), ColorPicker4() etc. +typedef int ImGuiConfigFlags; // -> enum ImGuiConfigFlags_ // Flags: for io.ConfigFlags +typedef int ImGuiComboFlags; // -> enum ImGuiComboFlags_ // Flags: for BeginCombo() +typedef int ImGuiDragDropFlags; // -> enum ImGuiDragDropFlags_ // Flags: for BeginDragDropSource(), AcceptDragDropPayload() +typedef int ImGuiFocusedFlags; // -> enum ImGuiFocusedFlags_ // Flags: for IsWindowFocused() +typedef int ImGuiHoveredFlags; // -> enum ImGuiHoveredFlags_ // Flags: for IsItemHovered(), IsWindowHovered() etc. +typedef int ImGuiInputTextFlags; // -> enum ImGuiInputTextFlags_ // Flags: for InputText(), InputTextMultiline() +typedef int ImGuiKeyModFlags; // -> enum ImGuiKeyModFlags_ // Flags: for io.KeyMods (Ctrl/Shift/Alt/Super) +typedef int ImGuiPopupFlags; // -> enum ImGuiPopupFlags_ // Flags: for OpenPopup*(), BeginPopupContext*(), IsPopupOpen() +typedef int ImGuiSelectableFlags; // -> enum ImGuiSelectableFlags_ // Flags: for Selectable() +typedef int ImGuiSliderFlags; // -> enum ImGuiSliderFlags_ // Flags: for DragFloat(), DragInt(), SliderFloat(), SliderInt() etc. +typedef int ImGuiTabBarFlags; // -> enum ImGuiTabBarFlags_ // Flags: for BeginTabBar() +typedef int ImGuiTabItemFlags; // -> enum ImGuiTabItemFlags_ // Flags: for BeginTabItem() +typedef int ImGuiTableFlags; // -> enum ImGuiTableFlags_ // Flags: For BeginTable() +typedef int ImGuiTableColumnFlags; // -> enum ImGuiTableColumnFlags_// Flags: For TableSetupColumn() +typedef int ImGuiTableRowFlags; // -> enum ImGuiTableRowFlags_ // Flags: For TableNextRow() +typedef int ImGuiTreeNodeFlags; // -> enum ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_ // Flags: for TreeNode(), TreeNodeEx(), CollapsingHeader() +typedef int ImGuiViewportFlags; // -> enum ImGuiViewportFlags_ // Flags: for ImGuiViewport +typedef int ImGuiWindowFlags; // -> enum ImGuiWindowFlags_ // Flags: for Begin(), BeginChild() + +// ImTexture: user data for renderer backend to identify a texture [Compile-time configurable type] +// - To use something else than an opaque void* pointer: override with e.g. '#define ImTextureID MyTextureType*' in your imconfig.h file. +// - This can be whatever to you want it to be! read the FAQ about ImTextureID for details. +#ifndef ImTextureID +typedef void* ImTextureID; // Default: store a pointer or an integer fitting in a pointer (most renderer backends are ok with that) +#endif + +// ImDrawIdx: vertex index. [Compile-time configurable type] +// - To use 16-bit indices + allow large meshes: backend need to set 'io.BackendFlags |= ImGuiBackendFlags_RendererHasVtxOffset' and handle ImDrawCmd::VtxOffset (recommended). +// - To use 32-bit indices: override with '#define ImDrawIdx unsigned int' in your imconfig.h file. +#ifndef ImDrawIdx +typedef unsigned short ImDrawIdx; // Default: 16-bit (for maximum compatibility with renderer backends) +#endif + +// Scalar data types +typedef unsigned int ImGuiID;// A unique ID used by widgets (typically the result of hashing a stack of string) +typedef signed char ImS8; // 8-bit signed integer +typedef unsigned char ImU8; // 8-bit unsigned integer +typedef signed short ImS16; // 16-bit signed integer +typedef unsigned short ImU16; // 16-bit unsigned integer +typedef signed int ImS32; // 32-bit signed integer == int +typedef unsigned int ImU32; // 32-bit unsigned integer (often used to store packed colors) +#if defined(_MSC_VER) && !defined(__clang__) +typedef signed __int64 ImS64; // 64-bit signed integer (pre and post C++11 with Visual Studio) +typedef unsigned __int64 ImU64; // 64-bit unsigned integer (pre and post C++11 with Visual Studio) +#elif (defined(__clang__) || defined(__GNUC__)) && (__cplusplus < 201100) +#include +typedef int64_t ImS64; // 64-bit signed integer (pre C++11) +typedef uint64_t ImU64; // 64-bit unsigned integer (pre C++11) +#else +typedef signed long long ImS64; // 64-bit signed integer (post C++11) +typedef unsigned long long ImU64; // 64-bit unsigned integer (post C++11) +#endif + +// Character types +// (we generally use UTF-8 encoded string in the API. This is storage specifically for a decoded character used for keyboard input and display) +typedef unsigned short ImWchar16; // A single decoded U16 character/code point. We encode them as multi bytes UTF-8 when used in strings. +typedef unsigned int ImWchar32; // A single decoded U32 character/code point. We encode them as multi bytes UTF-8 when used in strings. +#ifdef IMGUI_USE_WCHAR32 // ImWchar [configurable type: override in imconfig.h with '#define IMGUI_USE_WCHAR32' to support Unicode planes 1-16] +typedef ImWchar32 ImWchar; +#else +typedef ImWchar16 ImWchar; +#endif + +// Callback and functions types +typedef int (*ImGuiInputTextCallback)(ImGuiInputTextCallbackData* data); // Callback function for ImGui::InputText() +typedef void (*ImGuiSizeCallback)(ImGuiSizeCallbackData* data); // Callback function for ImGui::SetNextWindowSizeConstraints() +typedef void* (*ImGuiMemAllocFunc)(size_t sz, void* user_data); // Function signature for ImGui::SetAllocatorFunctions() +typedef void (*ImGuiMemFreeFunc)(void* ptr, void* user_data); // Function signature for ImGui::SetAllocatorFunctions() + +// ImVec2: 2D vector used to store positions, sizes etc. [Compile-time configurable type] +// This is a frequently used type in the API. Consider using IM_VEC2_CLASS_EXTRA to create implicit cast from/to our preferred type. +IM_MSVC_RUNTIME_CHECKS_OFF +struct ImVec2 +{ + float x, y; + ImVec2() { x = y = 0.0f; } + ImVec2(float _x, float _y) { x = _x; y = _y; } + float operator[] (size_t idx) const { IM_ASSERT(idx <= 1); return (&x)[idx]; } // We very rarely use this [] operator, the assert overhead is fine. + float& operator[] (size_t idx) { IM_ASSERT(idx <= 1); return (&x)[idx]; } // We very rarely use this [] operator, the assert overhead is fine. +#ifdef IM_VEC2_CLASS_EXTRA + IM_VEC2_CLASS_EXTRA // Define additional constructors and implicit cast operators in imconfig.h to convert back and forth between your math types and ImVec2. +#endif +}; + +// ImVec4: 4D vector used to store clipping rectangles, colors etc. [Compile-time configurable type] +struct ImVec4 +{ + float x, y, z, w; + ImVec4() { x = y = z = w = 0.0f; } + ImVec4(float _x, float _y, float _z, float _w) { x = _x; y = _y; z = _z; w = _w; } +#ifdef IM_VEC4_CLASS_EXTRA + IM_VEC4_CLASS_EXTRA // Define additional constructors and implicit cast operators in imconfig.h to convert back and forth between your math types and ImVec4. +#endif +}; +IM_MSVC_RUNTIME_CHECKS_RESTORE + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Dear ImGui end-user API functions +// (Note that ImGui:: being a namespace, you can add extra ImGui:: functions in your own separate file. Please don't modify imgui source files!) +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +namespace ImGui +{ + // Context creation and access + // - Each context create its own ImFontAtlas by default. You may instance one yourself and pass it to CreateContext() to share a font atlas between contexts. + // - DLL users: heaps and globals are not shared across DLL boundaries! You will need to call SetCurrentContext() + SetAllocatorFunctions() + // for each static/DLL boundary you are calling from. Read "Context and Memory Allocators" section of imgui.cpp for details. + IMGUI_API ImGuiContext* CreateContext(ImFontAtlas* shared_font_atlas = NULL); + IMGUI_API void DestroyContext(ImGuiContext* ctx = NULL); // NULL = destroy current context + IMGUI_API ImGuiContext* GetCurrentContext(); + IMGUI_API void SetCurrentContext(ImGuiContext* ctx); + + // Main + IMGUI_API ImGuiIO& GetIO(); // access the IO structure (mouse/keyboard/gamepad inputs, time, various configuration options/flags) + IMGUI_API ImGuiStyle& GetStyle(); // access the Style structure (colors, sizes). Always use PushStyleCol(), PushStyleVar() to modify style mid-frame! + IMGUI_API void NewFrame(); // start a new Dear ImGui frame, you can submit any command from this point until Render()/EndFrame(). + IMGUI_API void EndFrame(); // ends the Dear ImGui frame. automatically called by Render(). If you don't need to render data (skipping rendering) you may call EndFrame() without Render()... but you'll have wasted CPU already! If you don't need to render, better to not create any windows and not call NewFrame() at all! + IMGUI_API void Render(); // ends the Dear ImGui frame, finalize the draw data. You can then get call GetDrawData(). + IMGUI_API ImDrawData* GetDrawData(); // valid after Render() and until the next call to NewFrame(). this is what you have to render. + + // Demo, Debug, Information + IMGUI_API void ShowDemoWindow(bool* p_open = NULL); // create Demo window. demonstrate most ImGui features. call this to learn about the library! try to make it always available in your application! + IMGUI_API void ShowMetricsWindow(bool* p_open = NULL); // create Metrics/Debugger window. display Dear ImGui internals: windows, draw commands, various internal state, etc. + IMGUI_API void ShowAboutWindow(bool* p_open = NULL); // create About window. display Dear ImGui version, credits and build/system information. + IMGUI_API void ShowStyleEditor(ImGuiStyle* ref = NULL); // add style editor block (not a window). you can pass in a reference ImGuiStyle structure to compare to, revert to and save to (else it uses the default style) + IMGUI_API bool ShowStyleSelector(const char* label); // add style selector block (not a window), essentially a combo listing the default styles. + IMGUI_API void ShowFontSelector(const char* label); // add font selector block (not a window), essentially a combo listing the loaded fonts. + IMGUI_API void ShowUserGuide(); // add basic help/info block (not a window): how to manipulate ImGui as a end-user (mouse/keyboard controls). + IMGUI_API const char* GetVersion(); // get the compiled version string e.g. "1.80 WIP" (essentially the value for IMGUI_VERSION from the compiled version of imgui.cpp) + + // Styles + IMGUI_API void StyleColorsDark(ImGuiStyle* dst = NULL); // new, recommended style (default) + IMGUI_API void StyleColorsLight(ImGuiStyle* dst = NULL); // best used with borders and a custom, thicker font + IMGUI_API void StyleColorsClassic(ImGuiStyle* dst = NULL); // classic imgui style + + // Windows + // - Begin() = push window to the stack and start appending to it. End() = pop window from the stack. + // - Passing 'bool* p_open != NULL' shows a window-closing widget in the upper-right corner of the window, + // which clicking will set the boolean to false when clicked. + // - You may append multiple times to the same window during the same frame by calling Begin()/End() pairs multiple times. + // Some information such as 'flags' or 'p_open' will only be considered by the first call to Begin(). + // - Begin() return false to indicate the window is collapsed or fully clipped, so you may early out and omit submitting + // anything to the window. Always call a matching End() for each Begin() call, regardless of its return value! + // [Important: due to legacy reason, this is inconsistent with most other functions such as BeginMenu/EndMenu, + // BeginPopup/EndPopup, etc. where the EndXXX call should only be called if the corresponding BeginXXX function + // returned true. Begin and BeginChild are the only odd ones out. Will be fixed in a future update.] + // - Note that the bottom of window stack always contains a window called "Debug". + IMGUI_API bool Begin(const char* name, bool* p_open = NULL, ImGuiWindowFlags flags = 0); + IMGUI_API void End(); + + // Child Windows + // - Use child windows to begin into a self-contained independent scrolling/clipping regions within a host window. Child windows can embed their own child. + // - For each independent axis of 'size': ==0.0f: use remaining host window size / >0.0f: fixed size / <0.0f: use remaining window size minus abs(size) / Each axis can use a different mode, e.g. ImVec2(0,400). + // - BeginChild() returns false to indicate the window is collapsed or fully clipped, so you may early out and omit submitting anything to the window. + // Always call a matching EndChild() for each BeginChild() call, regardless of its return value. + // [Important: due to legacy reason, this is inconsistent with most other functions such as BeginMenu/EndMenu, + // BeginPopup/EndPopup, etc. where the EndXXX call should only be called if the corresponding BeginXXX function + // returned true. Begin and BeginChild are the only odd ones out. Will be fixed in a future update.] + IMGUI_API bool BeginChild(const char* str_id, const ImVec2& size = ImVec2(0, 0), bool border = false, ImGuiWindowFlags flags = 0); + IMGUI_API bool BeginChild(ImGuiID id, const ImVec2& size = ImVec2(0, 0), bool border = false, ImGuiWindowFlags flags = 0); + IMGUI_API void EndChild(); + + // Windows Utilities + // - 'current window' = the window we are appending into while inside a Begin()/End() block. 'next window' = next window we will Begin() into. + IMGUI_API bool IsWindowAppearing(); + IMGUI_API bool IsWindowCollapsed(); + IMGUI_API bool IsWindowFocused(ImGuiFocusedFlags flags=0); // is current window focused? or its root/child, depending on flags. see flags for options. + IMGUI_API bool IsWindowHovered(ImGuiHoveredFlags flags=0); // is current window hovered (and typically: not blocked by a popup/modal)? see flags for options. NB: If you are trying to check whether your mouse should be dispatched to imgui or to your app, you should use the 'io.WantCaptureMouse' boolean for that! Please read the FAQ! + IMGUI_API ImDrawList* GetWindowDrawList(); // get draw list associated to the current window, to append your own drawing primitives + IMGUI_API ImVec2 GetWindowPos(); // get current window position in screen space (useful if you want to do your own drawing via the DrawList API) + IMGUI_API ImVec2 GetWindowSize(); // get current window size + IMGUI_API float GetWindowWidth(); // get current window width (shortcut for GetWindowSize().x) + IMGUI_API float GetWindowHeight(); // get current window height (shortcut for GetWindowSize().y) + + // Window manipulation + // - Prefer using SetNextXXX functions (before Begin) rather that SetXXX functions (after Begin). + IMGUI_API void SetNextWindowPos(const ImVec2& pos, ImGuiCond cond = 0, const ImVec2& pivot = ImVec2(0, 0)); // set next window position. call before Begin(). use pivot=(0.5f,0.5f) to center on given point, etc. + IMGUI_API void SetNextWindowSize(const ImVec2& size, ImGuiCond cond = 0); // set next window size. set axis to 0.0f to force an auto-fit on this axis. call before Begin() + IMGUI_API void SetNextWindowSizeConstraints(const ImVec2& size_min, const ImVec2& size_max, ImGuiSizeCallback custom_callback = NULL, void* custom_callback_data = NULL); // set next window size limits. use -1,-1 on either X/Y axis to preserve the current size. Sizes will be rounded down. Use callback to apply non-trivial programmatic constraints. + IMGUI_API void SetNextWindowContentSize(const ImVec2& size); // set next window content size (~ scrollable client area, which enforce the range of scrollbars). Not including window decorations (title bar, menu bar, etc.) nor WindowPadding. set an axis to 0.0f to leave it automatic. call before Begin() + IMGUI_API void SetNextWindowCollapsed(bool collapsed, ImGuiCond cond = 0); // set next window collapsed state. call before Begin() + IMGUI_API void SetNextWindowFocus(); // set next window to be focused / top-most. call before Begin() + IMGUI_API void SetNextWindowBgAlpha(float alpha); // set next window background color alpha. helper to easily override the Alpha component of ImGuiCol_WindowBg/ChildBg/PopupBg. you may also use ImGuiWindowFlags_NoBackground. + IMGUI_API void SetWindowPos(const ImVec2& pos, ImGuiCond cond = 0); // (not recommended) set current window position - call within Begin()/End(). prefer using SetNextWindowPos(), as this may incur tearing and side-effects. + IMGUI_API void SetWindowSize(const ImVec2& size, ImGuiCond cond = 0); // (not recommended) set current window size - call within Begin()/End(). set to ImVec2(0, 0) to force an auto-fit. prefer using SetNextWindowSize(), as this may incur tearing and minor side-effects. + IMGUI_API void SetWindowCollapsed(bool collapsed, ImGuiCond cond = 0); // (not recommended) set current window collapsed state. prefer using SetNextWindowCollapsed(). + IMGUI_API void SetWindowFocus(); // (not recommended) set current window to be focused / top-most. prefer using SetNextWindowFocus(). + IMGUI_API void SetWindowFontScale(float scale); // [OBSOLETE] set font scale. Adjust IO.FontGlobalScale if you want to scale all windows. This is an old API! For correct scaling, prefer to reload font + rebuild ImFontAtlas + call style.ScaleAllSizes(). + IMGUI_API void SetWindowPos(const char* name, const ImVec2& pos, ImGuiCond cond = 0); // set named window position. + IMGUI_API void SetWindowSize(const char* name, const ImVec2& size, ImGuiCond cond = 0); // set named window size. set axis to 0.0f to force an auto-fit on this axis. + IMGUI_API void SetWindowCollapsed(const char* name, bool collapsed, ImGuiCond cond = 0); // set named window collapsed state + IMGUI_API void SetWindowFocus(const char* name); // set named window to be focused / top-most. use NULL to remove focus. + + // Content region + // - Retrieve available space from a given point. GetContentRegionAvail() is frequently useful. + // - Those functions are bound to be redesigned (they are confusing, incomplete and the Min/Max return values are in local window coordinates which increases confusion) + IMGUI_API ImVec2 GetContentRegionAvail(); // == GetContentRegionMax() - GetCursorPos() + IMGUI_API ImVec2 GetContentRegionMax(); // current content boundaries (typically window boundaries including scrolling, or current column boundaries), in windows coordinates + IMGUI_API ImVec2 GetWindowContentRegionMin(); // content boundaries min (roughly (0,0)-Scroll), in window coordinates + IMGUI_API ImVec2 GetWindowContentRegionMax(); // content boundaries max (roughly (0,0)+Size-Scroll) where Size can be override with SetNextWindowContentSize(), in window coordinates + IMGUI_API float GetWindowContentRegionWidth(); // + + // Windows Scrolling + IMGUI_API float GetScrollX(); // get scrolling amount [0 .. GetScrollMaxX()] + IMGUI_API float GetScrollY(); // get scrolling amount [0 .. GetScrollMaxY()] + IMGUI_API void SetScrollX(float scroll_x); // set scrolling amount [0 .. GetScrollMaxX()] + IMGUI_API void SetScrollY(float scroll_y); // set scrolling amount [0 .. GetScrollMaxY()] + IMGUI_API float GetScrollMaxX(); // get maximum scrolling amount ~~ ContentSize.x - WindowSize.x - DecorationsSize.x + IMGUI_API float GetScrollMaxY(); // get maximum scrolling amount ~~ ContentSize.y - WindowSize.y - DecorationsSize.y + IMGUI_API void SetScrollHereX(float center_x_ratio = 0.5f); // adjust scrolling amount to make current cursor position visible. center_x_ratio=0.0: left, 0.5: center, 1.0: right. When using to make a "default/current item" visible, consider using SetItemDefaultFocus() instead. + IMGUI_API void SetScrollHereY(float center_y_ratio = 0.5f); // adjust scrolling amount to make current cursor position visible. center_y_ratio=0.0: top, 0.5: center, 1.0: bottom. When using to make a "default/current item" visible, consider using SetItemDefaultFocus() instead. + IMGUI_API void SetScrollFromPosX(float local_x, float center_x_ratio = 0.5f); // adjust scrolling amount to make given position visible. Generally GetCursorStartPos() + offset to compute a valid position. + IMGUI_API void SetScrollFromPosY(float local_y, float center_y_ratio = 0.5f); // adjust scrolling amount to make given position visible. Generally GetCursorStartPos() + offset to compute a valid position. + + // Parameters stacks (shared) + IMGUI_API void PushFont(ImFont* font); // use NULL as a shortcut to push default font + IMGUI_API void PopFont(); + IMGUI_API void PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol idx, ImU32 col); // modify a style color. always use this if you modify the style after NewFrame(). + IMGUI_API void PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol idx, const ImVec4& col); + IMGUI_API void PopStyleColor(int count = 1); + IMGUI_API void PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar idx, float val); // modify a style float variable. always use this if you modify the style after NewFrame(). + IMGUI_API void PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar idx, const ImVec2& val); // modify a style ImVec2 variable. always use this if you modify the style after NewFrame(). + IMGUI_API void PopStyleVar(int count = 1); + IMGUI_API void PushAllowKeyboardFocus(bool allow_keyboard_focus); // == tab stop enable. Allow focusing using TAB/Shift-TAB, enabled by default but you can disable it for certain widgets + IMGUI_API void PopAllowKeyboardFocus(); + IMGUI_API void PushButtonRepeat(bool repeat); // in 'repeat' mode, Button*() functions return repeated true in a typematic manner (using io.KeyRepeatDelay/io.KeyRepeatRate setting). Note that you can call IsItemActive() after any Button() to tell if the button is held in the current frame. + IMGUI_API void PopButtonRepeat(); + + // Parameters stacks (current window) + IMGUI_API void PushItemWidth(float item_width); // push width of items for common large "item+label" widgets. >0.0f: width in pixels, <0.0f align xx pixels to the right of window (so -FLT_MIN always align width to the right side). + IMGUI_API void PopItemWidth(); + IMGUI_API void SetNextItemWidth(float item_width); // set width of the _next_ common large "item+label" widget. >0.0f: width in pixels, <0.0f align xx pixels to the right of window (so -FLT_MIN always align width to the right side) + IMGUI_API float CalcItemWidth(); // width of item given pushed settings and current cursor position. NOT necessarily the width of last item unlike most 'Item' functions. + IMGUI_API void PushTextWrapPos(float wrap_local_pos_x = 0.0f); // push word-wrapping position for Text*() commands. < 0.0f: no wrapping; 0.0f: wrap to end of window (or column); > 0.0f: wrap at 'wrap_pos_x' position in window local space + IMGUI_API void PopTextWrapPos(); + + // Style read access + // - Use the style editor (ShowStyleEditor() function) to interactively see what the colors are) + IMGUI_API ImFont* GetFont(); // get current font + IMGUI_API float GetFontSize(); // get current font size (= height in pixels) of current font with current scale applied + IMGUI_API ImVec2 GetFontTexUvWhitePixel(); // get UV coordinate for a while pixel, useful to draw custom shapes via the ImDrawList API + IMGUI_API ImU32 GetColorU32(ImGuiCol idx, float alpha_mul = 1.0f); // retrieve given style color with style alpha applied and optional extra alpha multiplier, packed as a 32-bit value suitable for ImDrawList + IMGUI_API ImU32 GetColorU32(const ImVec4& col); // retrieve given color with style alpha applied, packed as a 32-bit value suitable for ImDrawList + IMGUI_API ImU32 GetColorU32(ImU32 col); // retrieve given color with style alpha applied, packed as a 32-bit value suitable for ImDrawList + IMGUI_API const ImVec4& GetStyleColorVec4(ImGuiCol idx); // retrieve style color as stored in ImGuiStyle structure. use to feed back into PushStyleColor(), otherwise use GetColorU32() to get style color with style alpha baked in. + + // Cursor / Layout + // - By "cursor" we mean the current output position. + // - The typical widget behavior is to output themselves at the current cursor position, then move the cursor one line down. + // - You can call SameLine() between widgets to undo the last carriage return and output at the right of the preceding widget. + // - Attention! We currently have inconsistencies between window-local and absolute positions we will aim to fix with future API: + // Window-local coordinates: SameLine(), GetCursorPos(), SetCursorPos(), GetCursorStartPos(), GetContentRegionMax(), GetWindowContentRegion*(), PushTextWrapPos() + // Absolute coordinate: GetCursorScreenPos(), SetCursorScreenPos(), all ImDrawList:: functions. + IMGUI_API void Separator(); // separator, generally horizontal. inside a menu bar or in horizontal layout mode, this becomes a vertical separator. + IMGUI_API void SameLine(float offset_from_start_x=0.0f, float spacing=-1.0f); // call between widgets or groups to layout them horizontally. X position given in window coordinates. + IMGUI_API void NewLine(); // undo a SameLine() or force a new line when in an horizontal-layout context. + IMGUI_API void Spacing(); // add vertical spacing. + IMGUI_API void Dummy(const ImVec2& size); // add a dummy item of given size. unlike InvisibleButton(), Dummy() won't take the mouse click or be navigable into. + IMGUI_API void Indent(float indent_w = 0.0f); // move content position toward the right, by indent_w, or style.IndentSpacing if indent_w <= 0 + IMGUI_API void Unindent(float indent_w = 0.0f); // move content position back to the left, by indent_w, or style.IndentSpacing if indent_w <= 0 + IMGUI_API void BeginGroup(); // lock horizontal starting position + IMGUI_API void EndGroup(); // unlock horizontal starting position + capture the whole group bounding box into one "item" (so you can use IsItemHovered() or layout primitives such as SameLine() on whole group, etc.) + IMGUI_API ImVec2 GetCursorPos(); // cursor position in window coordinates (relative to window position) + IMGUI_API float GetCursorPosX(); // (some functions are using window-relative coordinates, such as: GetCursorPos, GetCursorStartPos, GetContentRegionMax, GetWindowContentRegion* etc. + IMGUI_API float GetCursorPosY(); // other functions such as GetCursorScreenPos or everything in ImDrawList:: + IMGUI_API void SetCursorPos(const ImVec2& local_pos); // are using the main, absolute coordinate system. + IMGUI_API void SetCursorPosX(float local_x); // GetWindowPos() + GetCursorPos() == GetCursorScreenPos() etc.) + IMGUI_API void SetCursorPosY(float local_y); // + IMGUI_API ImVec2 GetCursorStartPos(); // initial cursor position in window coordinates + IMGUI_API ImVec2 GetCursorScreenPos(); // cursor position in absolute coordinates (useful to work with ImDrawList API). generally top-left == GetMainViewport()->Pos == (0,0) in single viewport mode, and bottom-right == GetMainViewport()->Pos+Size == io.DisplaySize in single-viewport mode. + IMGUI_API void SetCursorScreenPos(const ImVec2& pos); // cursor position in absolute coordinates + IMGUI_API void AlignTextToFramePadding(); // vertically align upcoming text baseline to FramePadding.y so that it will align properly to regularly framed items (call if you have text on a line before a framed item) + IMGUI_API float GetTextLineHeight(); // ~ FontSize + IMGUI_API float GetTextLineHeightWithSpacing(); // ~ FontSize + style.ItemSpacing.y (distance in pixels between 2 consecutive lines of text) + IMGUI_API float GetFrameHeight(); // ~ FontSize + style.FramePadding.y * 2 + IMGUI_API float GetFrameHeightWithSpacing(); // ~ FontSize + style.FramePadding.y * 2 + style.ItemSpacing.y (distance in pixels between 2 consecutive lines of framed widgets) + + // ID stack/scopes + // Read the FAQ (docs/FAQ.md or http://dearimgui.org/faq) for more details about how ID are handled in dear imgui. + // - Those questions are answered and impacted by understanding of the ID stack system: + // - "Q: Why is my widget not reacting when I click on it?" + // - "Q: How can I have widgets with an empty label?" + // - "Q: How can I have multiple widgets with the same label?" + // - Short version: ID are hashes of the entire ID stack. If you are creating widgets in a loop you most likely + // want to push a unique identifier (e.g. object pointer, loop index) to uniquely differentiate them. + // - You can also use the "Label##foobar" syntax within widget label to distinguish them from each others. + // - In this header file we use the "label"/"name" terminology to denote a string that will be displayed + used as an ID, + // whereas "str_id" denote a string that is only used as an ID and not normally displayed. + IMGUI_API void PushID(const char* str_id); // push string into the ID stack (will hash string). + IMGUI_API void PushID(const char* str_id_begin, const char* str_id_end); // push string into the ID stack (will hash string). + IMGUI_API void PushID(const void* ptr_id); // push pointer into the ID stack (will hash pointer). + IMGUI_API void PushID(int int_id); // push integer into the ID stack (will hash integer). + IMGUI_API void PopID(); // pop from the ID stack. + IMGUI_API ImGuiID GetID(const char* str_id); // calculate unique ID (hash of whole ID stack + given parameter). e.g. if you want to query into ImGuiStorage yourself + IMGUI_API ImGuiID GetID(const char* str_id_begin, const char* str_id_end); + IMGUI_API ImGuiID GetID(const void* ptr_id); + + // Widgets: Text + IMGUI_API void TextUnformatted(const char* text, const char* text_end = NULL); // raw text without formatting. Roughly equivalent to Text("%s", text) but: A) doesn't require null terminated string if 'text_end' is specified, B) it's faster, no memory copy is done, no buffer size limits, recommended for long chunks of text. + IMGUI_API void Text(const char* fmt, ...) IM_FMTARGS(1); // formatted text + IMGUI_API void TextV(const char* fmt, va_list args) IM_FMTLIST(1); + IMGUI_API void TextColored(const ImVec4& col, const char* fmt, ...) IM_FMTARGS(2); // shortcut for PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_Text, col); Text(fmt, ...); PopStyleColor(); + IMGUI_API void TextColoredV(const ImVec4& col, const char* fmt, va_list args) IM_FMTLIST(2); + IMGUI_API void TextDisabled(const char* fmt, ...) IM_FMTARGS(1); // shortcut for PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_Text, style.Colors[ImGuiCol_TextDisabled]); Text(fmt, ...); PopStyleColor(); + IMGUI_API void TextDisabledV(const char* fmt, va_list args) IM_FMTLIST(1); + IMGUI_API void TextWrapped(const char* fmt, ...) IM_FMTARGS(1); // shortcut for PushTextWrapPos(0.0f); Text(fmt, ...); PopTextWrapPos();. Note that this won't work on an auto-resizing window if there's no other widgets to extend the window width, yoy may need to set a size using SetNextWindowSize(). + IMGUI_API void TextWrappedV(const char* fmt, va_list args) IM_FMTLIST(1); + IMGUI_API void LabelText(const char* label, const char* fmt, ...) IM_FMTARGS(2); // display text+label aligned the same way as value+label widgets + IMGUI_API void LabelTextV(const char* label, const char* fmt, va_list args) IM_FMTLIST(2); + IMGUI_API void BulletText(const char* fmt, ...) IM_FMTARGS(1); // shortcut for Bullet()+Text() + IMGUI_API void BulletTextV(const char* fmt, va_list args) IM_FMTLIST(1); + + // Widgets: Main + // - Most widgets return true when the value has been changed or when pressed/selected + // - You may also use one of the many IsItemXXX functions (e.g. IsItemActive, IsItemHovered, etc.) to query widget state. + IMGUI_API bool Button(const char* label, const ImVec2& size = ImVec2(0, 0)); // button + IMGUI_API bool SmallButton(const char* label); // button with FramePadding=(0,0) to easily embed within text + IMGUI_API bool InvisibleButton(const char* str_id, const ImVec2& size, ImGuiButtonFlags flags = 0); // flexible button behavior without the visuals, frequently useful to build custom behaviors using the public api (along with IsItemActive, IsItemHovered, etc.) + IMGUI_API bool ArrowButton(const char* str_id, ImGuiDir dir); // square button with an arrow shape + IMGUI_API void Image(ImTextureID user_texture_id, const ImVec2& size, const ImVec2& uv0 = ImVec2(0, 0), const ImVec2& uv1 = ImVec2(1,1), const ImVec4& tint_col = ImVec4(1,1,1,1), const ImVec4& border_col = ImVec4(0,0,0,0)); + IMGUI_API bool ImageButton(ImTextureID user_texture_id, const ImVec2& size, const ImVec2& uv0 = ImVec2(0, 0), const ImVec2& uv1 = ImVec2(1,1), int frame_padding = -1, const ImVec4& bg_col = ImVec4(0,0,0,0), const ImVec4& tint_col = ImVec4(1,1,1,1)); // <0 frame_padding uses default frame padding settings. 0 for no padding + IMGUI_API bool Checkbox(const char* label, bool* v); + IMGUI_API bool CheckboxFlags(const char* label, int* flags, int flags_value); + IMGUI_API bool CheckboxFlags(const char* label, unsigned int* flags, unsigned int flags_value); + IMGUI_API bool RadioButton(const char* label, bool active); // use with e.g. if (RadioButton("one", my_value==1)) { my_value = 1; } + IMGUI_API bool RadioButton(const char* label, int* v, int v_button); // shortcut to handle the above pattern when value is an integer + IMGUI_API void ProgressBar(float fraction, const ImVec2& size_arg = ImVec2(-FLT_MIN, 0), const char* overlay = NULL); + IMGUI_API void Bullet(); // draw a small circle + keep the cursor on the same line. advance cursor x position by GetTreeNodeToLabelSpacing(), same distance that TreeNode() uses + + // Widgets: Combo Box + // - The BeginCombo()/EndCombo() api allows you to manage your contents and selection state however you want it, by creating e.g. Selectable() items. + // - The old Combo() api are helpers over BeginCombo()/EndCombo() which are kept available for convenience purpose. This is analogous to how ListBox are created. + IMGUI_API bool BeginCombo(const char* label, const char* preview_value, ImGuiComboFlags flags = 0); + IMGUI_API void EndCombo(); // only call EndCombo() if BeginCombo() returns true! + IMGUI_API bool Combo(const char* label, int* current_item, const char* const items[], int items_count, int popup_max_height_in_items = -1); + IMGUI_API bool Combo(const char* label, int* current_item, const char* items_separated_by_zeros, int popup_max_height_in_items = -1); // Separate items with \0 within a string, end item-list with \0\0. e.g. "One\0Two\0Three\0" + IMGUI_API bool Combo(const char* label, int* current_item, bool(*items_getter)(void* data, int idx, const char** out_text), void* data, int items_count, int popup_max_height_in_items = -1); + + // Widgets: Drag Sliders + // - CTRL+Click on any drag box to turn them into an input box. Manually input values aren't clamped and can go off-bounds. + // - For all the Float2/Float3/Float4/Int2/Int3/Int4 versions of every functions, note that a 'float v[X]' function argument is the same as 'float* v', the array syntax is just a way to document the number of elements that are expected to be accessible. You can pass address of your first element out of a contiguous set, e.g. &myvector.x + // - Adjust format string to decorate the value with a prefix, a suffix, or adapt the editing and display precision e.g. "%.3f" -> 1.234; "%5.2f secs" -> 01.23 secs; "Biscuit: %.0f" -> Biscuit: 1; etc. + // - Format string may also be set to NULL or use the default format ("%f" or "%d"). + // - Speed are per-pixel of mouse movement (v_speed=0.2f: mouse needs to move by 5 pixels to increase value by 1). For gamepad/keyboard navigation, minimum speed is Max(v_speed, minimum_step_at_given_precision). + // - Use v_min < v_max to clamp edits to given limits. Note that CTRL+Click manual input can override those limits. + // - Use v_max = FLT_MAX / INT_MAX etc to avoid clamping to a maximum, same with v_min = -FLT_MAX / INT_MIN to avoid clamping to a minimum. + // - We use the same sets of flags for DragXXX() and SliderXXX() functions as the features are the same and it makes it easier to swap them. + // - Legacy: Pre-1.78 there are DragXXX() function signatures that takes a final `float power=1.0f' argument instead of the `ImGuiSliderFlags flags=0' argument. + // If you get a warning converting a float to ImGuiSliderFlags, read https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/issues/3361 + IMGUI_API bool DragFloat(const char* label, float* v, float v_speed = 1.0f, float v_min = 0.0f, float v_max = 0.0f, const char* format = "%.3f", ImGuiSliderFlags flags = 0); // If v_min >= v_max we have no bound + IMGUI_API bool DragFloat2(const char* label, float v[2], float v_speed = 1.0f, float v_min = 0.0f, float v_max = 0.0f, const char* format = "%.3f", ImGuiSliderFlags flags = 0); + IMGUI_API bool DragFloat3(const char* label, float v[3], float v_speed = 1.0f, float v_min = 0.0f, float v_max = 0.0f, const char* format = "%.3f", ImGuiSliderFlags flags = 0); + IMGUI_API bool DragFloat4(const char* label, float v[4], float v_speed = 1.0f, float v_min = 0.0f, float v_max = 0.0f, const char* format = "%.3f", ImGuiSliderFlags flags = 0); + IMGUI_API bool DragFloatRange2(const char* label, float* v_current_min, float* v_current_max, float v_speed = 1.0f, float v_min = 0.0f, float v_max = 0.0f, const char* format = "%.3f", const char* format_max = NULL, ImGuiSliderFlags flags = 0); + IMGUI_API bool DragInt(const char* label, int* v, float v_speed = 1.0f, int v_min = 0, int v_max = 0, const char* format = "%d", ImGuiSliderFlags flags = 0); // If v_min >= v_max we have no bound + IMGUI_API bool DragInt2(const char* label, int v[2], float v_speed = 1.0f, int v_min = 0, int v_max = 0, const char* format = "%d", ImGuiSliderFlags flags = 0); + IMGUI_API bool DragInt3(const char* label, int v[3], float v_speed = 1.0f, int v_min = 0, int v_max = 0, const char* format = "%d", ImGuiSliderFlags flags = 0); + IMGUI_API bool DragInt4(const char* label, int v[4], float v_speed = 1.0f, int v_min = 0, int v_max = 0, const char* format = "%d", ImGuiSliderFlags flags = 0); + IMGUI_API bool DragIntRange2(const char* label, int* v_current_min, int* v_current_max, float v_speed = 1.0f, int v_min = 0, int v_max = 0, const char* format = "%d", const char* format_max = NULL, ImGuiSliderFlags flags = 0); + IMGUI_API bool DragScalar(const char* label, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* p_data, float v_speed = 1.0f, const void* p_min = NULL, const void* p_max = NULL, const char* format = NULL, ImGuiSliderFlags flags = 0); + IMGUI_API bool DragScalarN(const char* label, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* p_data, int components, float v_speed = 1.0f, const void* p_min = NULL, const void* p_max = NULL, const char* format = NULL, ImGuiSliderFlags flags = 0); + + // Widgets: Regular Sliders + // - CTRL+Click on any slider to turn them into an input box. Manually input values aren't clamped and can go off-bounds. + // - Adjust format string to decorate the value with a prefix, a suffix, or adapt the editing and display precision e.g. "%.3f" -> 1.234; "%5.2f secs" -> 01.23 secs; "Biscuit: %.0f" -> Biscuit: 1; etc. + // - Format string may also be set to NULL or use the default format ("%f" or "%d"). + // - Legacy: Pre-1.78 there are SliderXXX() function signatures that takes a final `float power=1.0f' argument instead of the `ImGuiSliderFlags flags=0' argument. + // If you get a warning converting a float to ImGuiSliderFlags, read https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/issues/3361 + IMGUI_API bool SliderFloat(const char* label, float* v, float v_min, float v_max, const char* format = "%.3f", ImGuiSliderFlags flags = 0); // adjust format to decorate the value with a prefix or a suffix for in-slider labels or unit display. + IMGUI_API bool SliderFloat2(const char* label, float v[2], float v_min, float v_max, const char* format = "%.3f", ImGuiSliderFlags flags = 0); + IMGUI_API bool SliderFloat3(const char* label, float v[3], float v_min, float v_max, const char* format = "%.3f", ImGuiSliderFlags flags = 0); + IMGUI_API bool SliderFloat4(const char* label, float v[4], float v_min, float v_max, const char* format = "%.3f", ImGuiSliderFlags flags = 0); + IMGUI_API bool SliderAngle(const char* label, float* v_rad, float v_degrees_min = -360.0f, float v_degrees_max = +360.0f, const char* format = "%.0f deg", ImGuiSliderFlags flags = 0); + IMGUI_API bool SliderInt(const char* label, int* v, int v_min, int v_max, const char* format = "%d", ImGuiSliderFlags flags = 0); + IMGUI_API bool SliderInt2(const char* label, int v[2], int v_min, int v_max, const char* format = "%d", ImGuiSliderFlags flags = 0); + IMGUI_API bool SliderInt3(const char* label, int v[3], int v_min, int v_max, const char* format = "%d", ImGuiSliderFlags flags = 0); + IMGUI_API bool SliderInt4(const char* label, int v[4], int v_min, int v_max, const char* format = "%d", ImGuiSliderFlags flags = 0); + IMGUI_API bool SliderScalar(const char* label, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* p_data, const void* p_min, const void* p_max, const char* format = NULL, ImGuiSliderFlags flags = 0); + IMGUI_API bool SliderScalarN(const char* label, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* p_data, int components, const void* p_min, const void* p_max, const char* format = NULL, ImGuiSliderFlags flags = 0); + IMGUI_API bool VSliderFloat(const char* label, const ImVec2& size, float* v, float v_min, float v_max, const char* format = "%.3f", ImGuiSliderFlags flags = 0); + IMGUI_API bool VSliderInt(const char* label, const ImVec2& size, int* v, int v_min, int v_max, const char* format = "%d", ImGuiSliderFlags flags = 0); + IMGUI_API bool VSliderScalar(const char* label, const ImVec2& size, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* p_data, const void* p_min, const void* p_max, const char* format = NULL, ImGuiSliderFlags flags = 0); + + // Widgets: Input with Keyboard + // - If you want to use InputText() with std::string or any custom dynamic string type, see misc/cpp/imgui_stdlib.h and comments in imgui_demo.cpp. + // - Most of the ImGuiInputTextFlags flags are only useful for InputText() and not for InputFloatX, InputIntX, InputDouble etc. + IMGUI_API bool InputText(const char* label, char* buf, size_t buf_size, ImGuiInputTextFlags flags = 0, ImGuiInputTextCallback callback = NULL, void* user_data = NULL); + IMGUI_API bool InputTextMultiline(const char* label, char* buf, size_t buf_size, const ImVec2& size = ImVec2(0, 0), ImGuiInputTextFlags flags = 0, ImGuiInputTextCallback callback = NULL, void* user_data = NULL); + IMGUI_API bool InputTextWithHint(const char* label, const char* hint, char* buf, size_t buf_size, ImGuiInputTextFlags flags = 0, ImGuiInputTextCallback callback = NULL, void* user_data = NULL); + IMGUI_API bool InputFloat(const char* label, float* v, float step = 0.0f, float step_fast = 0.0f, const char* format = "%.3f", ImGuiInputTextFlags flags = 0); + IMGUI_API bool InputFloat2(const char* label, float v[2], const char* format = "%.3f", ImGuiInputTextFlags flags = 0); + IMGUI_API bool InputFloat3(const char* label, float v[3], const char* format = "%.3f", ImGuiInputTextFlags flags = 0); + IMGUI_API bool InputFloat4(const char* label, float v[4], const char* format = "%.3f", ImGuiInputTextFlags flags = 0); + IMGUI_API bool InputInt(const char* label, int* v, int step = 1, int step_fast = 100, ImGuiInputTextFlags flags = 0); + IMGUI_API bool InputInt2(const char* label, int v[2], ImGuiInputTextFlags flags = 0); + IMGUI_API bool InputInt3(const char* label, int v[3], ImGuiInputTextFlags flags = 0); + IMGUI_API bool InputInt4(const char* label, int v[4], ImGuiInputTextFlags flags = 0); + IMGUI_API bool InputDouble(const char* label, double* v, double step = 0.0, double step_fast = 0.0, const char* format = "%.6f", ImGuiInputTextFlags flags = 0); + IMGUI_API bool InputScalar(const char* label, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* p_data, const void* p_step = NULL, const void* p_step_fast = NULL, const char* format = NULL, ImGuiInputTextFlags flags = 0); + IMGUI_API bool InputScalarN(const char* label, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* p_data, int components, const void* p_step = NULL, const void* p_step_fast = NULL, const char* format = NULL, ImGuiInputTextFlags flags = 0); + + // Widgets: Color Editor/Picker (tip: the ColorEdit* functions have a little color square that can be left-clicked to open a picker, and right-clicked to open an option menu.) + // - Note that in C++ a 'float v[X]' function argument is the _same_ as 'float* v', the array syntax is just a way to document the number of elements that are expected to be accessible. + // - You can pass the address of a first float element out of a contiguous structure, e.g. &myvector.x + IMGUI_API bool ColorEdit3(const char* label, float col[3], ImGuiColorEditFlags flags = 0); + IMGUI_API bool ColorEdit4(const char* label, float col[4], ImGuiColorEditFlags flags = 0); + IMGUI_API bool ColorPicker3(const char* label, float col[3], ImGuiColorEditFlags flags = 0); + IMGUI_API bool ColorPicker4(const char* label, float col[4], ImGuiColorEditFlags flags = 0, const float* ref_col = NULL); + IMGUI_API bool ColorButton(const char* desc_id, const ImVec4& col, ImGuiColorEditFlags flags = 0, ImVec2 size = ImVec2(0, 0)); // display a color square/button, hover for details, return true when pressed. + IMGUI_API void SetColorEditOptions(ImGuiColorEditFlags flags); // initialize current options (generally on application startup) if you want to select a default format, picker type, etc. User will be able to change many settings, unless you pass the _NoOptions flag to your calls. + + // Widgets: Trees + // - TreeNode functions return true when the node is open, in which case you need to also call TreePop() when you are finished displaying the tree node contents. + IMGUI_API bool TreeNode(const char* label); + IMGUI_API bool TreeNode(const char* str_id, const char* fmt, ...) IM_FMTARGS(2); // helper variation to easily decorelate the id from the displayed string. Read the FAQ about why and how to use ID. to align arbitrary text at the same level as a TreeNode() you can use Bullet(). + IMGUI_API bool TreeNode(const void* ptr_id, const char* fmt, ...) IM_FMTARGS(2); // " + IMGUI_API bool TreeNodeV(const char* str_id, const char* fmt, va_list args) IM_FMTLIST(2); + IMGUI_API bool TreeNodeV(const void* ptr_id, const char* fmt, va_list args) IM_FMTLIST(2); + IMGUI_API bool TreeNodeEx(const char* label, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags = 0); + IMGUI_API bool TreeNodeEx(const char* str_id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags, const char* fmt, ...) IM_FMTARGS(3); + IMGUI_API bool TreeNodeEx(const void* ptr_id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags, const char* fmt, ...) IM_FMTARGS(3); + IMGUI_API bool TreeNodeExV(const char* str_id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags, const char* fmt, va_list args) IM_FMTLIST(3); + IMGUI_API bool TreeNodeExV(const void* ptr_id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags, const char* fmt, va_list args) IM_FMTLIST(3); + IMGUI_API void TreePush(const char* str_id); // ~ Indent()+PushId(). Already called by TreeNode() when returning true, but you can call TreePush/TreePop yourself if desired. + IMGUI_API void TreePush(const void* ptr_id = NULL); // " + IMGUI_API void TreePop(); // ~ Unindent()+PopId() + IMGUI_API float GetTreeNodeToLabelSpacing(); // horizontal distance preceding label when using TreeNode*() or Bullet() == (g.FontSize + style.FramePadding.x*2) for a regular unframed TreeNode + IMGUI_API bool CollapsingHeader(const char* label, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags = 0); // if returning 'true' the header is open. doesn't indent nor push on ID stack. user doesn't have to call TreePop(). + IMGUI_API bool CollapsingHeader(const char* label, bool* p_visible, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags = 0); // when 'p_visible != NULL': if '*p_visible==true' display an additional small close button on upper right of the header which will set the bool to false when clicked, if '*p_visible==false' don't display the header. + IMGUI_API void SetNextItemOpen(bool is_open, ImGuiCond cond = 0); // set next TreeNode/CollapsingHeader open state. + + // Widgets: Selectables + // - A selectable highlights when hovered, and can display another color when selected. + // - Neighbors selectable extend their highlight bounds in order to leave no gap between them. This is so a series of selected Selectable appear contiguous. + IMGUI_API bool Selectable(const char* label, bool selected = false, ImGuiSelectableFlags flags = 0, const ImVec2& size = ImVec2(0, 0)); // "bool selected" carry the selection state (read-only). Selectable() is clicked is returns true so you can modify your selection state. size.x==0.0: use remaining width, size.x>0.0: specify width. size.y==0.0: use label height, size.y>0.0: specify height + IMGUI_API bool Selectable(const char* label, bool* p_selected, ImGuiSelectableFlags flags = 0, const ImVec2& size = ImVec2(0, 0)); // "bool* p_selected" point to the selection state (read-write), as a convenient helper. + + // Widgets: List Boxes + // - This is essentially a thin wrapper to using BeginChild/EndChild with some stylistic changes. + // - The BeginListBox()/EndListBox() api allows you to manage your contents and selection state however you want it, by creating e.g. Selectable() or any items. + // - The simplified/old ListBox() api are helpers over BeginListBox()/EndListBox() which are kept available for convenience purpose. This is analoguous to how Combos are created. + // - Choose frame width: size.x > 0.0f: custom / size.x < 0.0f or -FLT_MIN: right-align / size.x = 0.0f (default): use current ItemWidth + // - Choose frame height: size.y > 0.0f: custom / size.y < 0.0f or -FLT_MIN: bottom-align / size.y = 0.0f (default): arbitrary default height which can fit ~7 items + IMGUI_API bool BeginListBox(const char* label, const ImVec2& size = ImVec2(0, 0)); // open a framed scrolling region + IMGUI_API void EndListBox(); // only call EndListBox() if BeginListBox() returned true! + IMGUI_API bool ListBox(const char* label, int* current_item, const char* const items[], int items_count, int height_in_items = -1); + IMGUI_API bool ListBox(const char* label, int* current_item, bool (*items_getter)(void* data, int idx, const char** out_text), void* data, int items_count, int height_in_items = -1); + + // Widgets: Data Plotting + // - Consider using ImPlot (https://github.com/epezent/implot) which is much better! + IMGUI_API void PlotLines(const char* label, const float* values, int values_count, int values_offset = 0, const char* overlay_text = NULL, float scale_min = FLT_MAX, float scale_max = FLT_MAX, ImVec2 graph_size = ImVec2(0, 0), int stride = sizeof(float)); + IMGUI_API void PlotLines(const char* label, float(*values_getter)(void* data, int idx), void* data, int values_count, int values_offset = 0, const char* overlay_text = NULL, float scale_min = FLT_MAX, float scale_max = FLT_MAX, ImVec2 graph_size = ImVec2(0, 0)); + IMGUI_API void PlotHistogram(const char* label, const float* values, int values_count, int values_offset = 0, const char* overlay_text = NULL, float scale_min = FLT_MAX, float scale_max = FLT_MAX, ImVec2 graph_size = ImVec2(0, 0), int stride = sizeof(float)); + IMGUI_API void PlotHistogram(const char* label, float(*values_getter)(void* data, int idx), void* data, int values_count, int values_offset = 0, const char* overlay_text = NULL, float scale_min = FLT_MAX, float scale_max = FLT_MAX, ImVec2 graph_size = ImVec2(0, 0)); + + // Widgets: Value() Helpers. + // - Those are merely shortcut to calling Text() with a format string. Output single value in "name: value" format (tip: freely declare more in your code to handle your types. you can add functions to the ImGui namespace) + IMGUI_API void Value(const char* prefix, bool b); + IMGUI_API void Value(const char* prefix, int v); + IMGUI_API void Value(const char* prefix, unsigned int v); + IMGUI_API void Value(const char* prefix, float v, const char* float_format = NULL); + + // Widgets: Menus + // - Use BeginMenuBar() on a window ImGuiWindowFlags_MenuBar to append to its menu bar. + // - Use BeginMainMenuBar() to create a menu bar at the top of the screen and append to it. + // - Use BeginMenu() to create a menu. You can call BeginMenu() multiple time with the same identifier to append more items to it. + // - Not that MenuItem() keyboardshortcuts are displayed as a convenience but _not processed_ by Dear ImGui at the moment. + IMGUI_API bool BeginMenuBar(); // append to menu-bar of current window (requires ImGuiWindowFlags_MenuBar flag set on parent window). + IMGUI_API void EndMenuBar(); // only call EndMenuBar() if BeginMenuBar() returns true! + IMGUI_API bool BeginMainMenuBar(); // create and append to a full screen menu-bar. + IMGUI_API void EndMainMenuBar(); // only call EndMainMenuBar() if BeginMainMenuBar() returns true! + IMGUI_API bool BeginMenu(const char* label, bool enabled = true); // create a sub-menu entry. only call EndMenu() if this returns true! + IMGUI_API void EndMenu(); // only call EndMenu() if BeginMenu() returns true! + IMGUI_API bool MenuItem(const char* label, const char* shortcut = NULL, bool selected = false, bool enabled = true); // return true when activated. + IMGUI_API bool MenuItem(const char* label, const char* shortcut, bool* p_selected, bool enabled = true); // return true when activated + toggle (*p_selected) if p_selected != NULL + + // Tooltips + // - Tooltip are windows following the mouse. They do not take focus away. + IMGUI_API void BeginTooltip(); // begin/append a tooltip window. to create full-featured tooltip (with any kind of items). + IMGUI_API void EndTooltip(); + IMGUI_API void SetTooltip(const char* fmt, ...) IM_FMTARGS(1); // set a text-only tooltip, typically use with ImGui::IsItemHovered(). override any previous call to SetTooltip(). + IMGUI_API void SetTooltipV(const char* fmt, va_list args) IM_FMTLIST(1); + + // Popups, Modals + // - They block normal mouse hovering detection (and therefore most mouse interactions) behind them. + // - If not modal: they can be closed by clicking anywhere outside them, or by pressing ESCAPE. + // - Their visibility state (~bool) is held internally instead of being held by the programmer as we are used to with regular Begin*() calls. + // - The 3 properties above are related: we need to retain popup visibility state in the library because popups may be closed as any time. + // - You can bypass the hovering restriction by using ImGuiHoveredFlags_AllowWhenBlockedByPopup when calling IsItemHovered() or IsWindowHovered(). + // - IMPORTANT: Popup identifiers are relative to the current ID stack, so OpenPopup and BeginPopup generally needs to be at the same level of the stack. + // This is sometimes leading to confusing mistakes. May rework this in the future. + + // Popups: begin/end functions + // - BeginPopup(): query popup state, if open start appending into the window. Call EndPopup() afterwards. ImGuiWindowFlags are forwarded to the window. + // - BeginPopupModal(): block every interactions behind the window, cannot be closed by user, add a dimming background, has a title bar. + IMGUI_API bool BeginPopup(const char* str_id, ImGuiWindowFlags flags = 0); // return true if the popup is open, and you can start outputting to it. + IMGUI_API bool BeginPopupModal(const char* name, bool* p_open = NULL, ImGuiWindowFlags flags = 0); // return true if the modal is open, and you can start outputting to it. + IMGUI_API void EndPopup(); // only call EndPopup() if BeginPopupXXX() returns true! + + // Popups: open/close functions + // - OpenPopup(): set popup state to open. ImGuiPopupFlags are available for opening options. + // - If not modal: they can be closed by clicking anywhere outside them, or by pressing ESCAPE. + // - CloseCurrentPopup(): use inside the BeginPopup()/EndPopup() scope to close manually. + // - CloseCurrentPopup() is called by default by Selectable()/MenuItem() when activated (FIXME: need some options). + // - Use ImGuiPopupFlags_NoOpenOverExistingPopup to avoid opening a popup if there's already one at the same level. This is equivalent to e.g. testing for !IsAnyPopupOpen() prior to OpenPopup(). + // - Use IsWindowAppearing() after BeginPopup() to tell if a window just opened. + IMGUI_API void OpenPopup(const char* str_id, ImGuiPopupFlags popup_flags = 0); // call to mark popup as open (don't call every frame!). + IMGUI_API void OpenPopup(ImGuiID id, ImGuiPopupFlags popup_flags = 0); // id overload to facilitate calling from nested stacks + IMGUI_API void OpenPopupOnItemClick(const char* str_id = NULL, ImGuiPopupFlags popup_flags = 1); // helper to open popup when clicked on last item. Default to ImGuiPopupFlags_MouseButtonRight == 1. (note: actually triggers on the mouse _released_ event to be consistent with popup behaviors) + IMGUI_API void CloseCurrentPopup(); // manually close the popup we have begin-ed into. + + // Popups: open+begin combined functions helpers + // - Helpers to do OpenPopup+BeginPopup where the Open action is triggered by e.g. hovering an item and right-clicking. + // - They are convenient to easily create context menus, hence the name. + // - IMPORTANT: Notice that BeginPopupContextXXX takes ImGuiPopupFlags just like OpenPopup() and unlike BeginPopup(). For full consistency, we may add ImGuiWindowFlags to the BeginPopupContextXXX functions in the future. + // - IMPORTANT: we exceptionally default their flags to 1 (== ImGuiPopupFlags_MouseButtonRight) for backward compatibility with older API taking 'int mouse_button = 1' parameter, so if you add other flags remember to re-add the ImGuiPopupFlags_MouseButtonRight. + IMGUI_API bool BeginPopupContextItem(const char* str_id = NULL, ImGuiPopupFlags popup_flags = 1); // open+begin popup when clicked on last item. Use str_id==NULL to associate the popup to previous item. If you want to use that on a non-interactive item such as Text() you need to pass in an explicit ID here. read comments in .cpp! + IMGUI_API bool BeginPopupContextWindow(const char* str_id = NULL, ImGuiPopupFlags popup_flags = 1);// open+begin popup when clicked on current window. + IMGUI_API bool BeginPopupContextVoid(const char* str_id = NULL, ImGuiPopupFlags popup_flags = 1); // open+begin popup when clicked in void (where there are no windows). + + // Popups: query functions + // - IsPopupOpen(): return true if the popup is open at the current BeginPopup() level of the popup stack. + // - IsPopupOpen() with ImGuiPopupFlags_AnyPopupId: return true if any popup is open at the current BeginPopup() level of the popup stack. + // - IsPopupOpen() with ImGuiPopupFlags_AnyPopupId + ImGuiPopupFlags_AnyPopupLevel: return true if any popup is open. + IMGUI_API bool IsPopupOpen(const char* str_id, ImGuiPopupFlags flags = 0); // return true if the popup is open. + + // Tables + // [BETA API] API may evolve slightly! If you use this, please update to the next version when it comes out! + // - Full-featured replacement for old Columns API. + // - See Demo->Tables for demo code. + // - See top of imgui_tables.cpp for general commentary. + // - See ImGuiTableFlags_ and ImGuiTableColumnFlags_ enums for a description of available flags. + // The typical call flow is: + // - 1. Call BeginTable(). + // - 2. Optionally call TableSetupColumn() to submit column name/flags/defaults. + // - 3. Optionally call TableSetupScrollFreeze() to request scroll freezing of columns/rows. + // - 4. Optionally call TableHeadersRow() to submit a header row. Names are pulled from TableSetupColumn() data. + // - 5. Populate contents: + // - In most situations you can use TableNextRow() + TableSetColumnIndex(N) to start appending into a column. + // - If you are using tables as a sort of grid, where every columns is holding the same type of contents, + // you may prefer using TableNextColumn() instead of TableNextRow() + TableSetColumnIndex(). + // TableNextColumn() will automatically wrap-around into the next row if needed. + // - IMPORTANT: Comparatively to the old Columns() API, we need to call TableNextColumn() for the first column! + // - Summary of possible call flow: + // -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- + // TableNextRow() -> TableSetColumnIndex(0) -> Text("Hello 0") -> TableSetColumnIndex(1) -> Text("Hello 1") // OK + // TableNextRow() -> TableNextColumn() -> Text("Hello 0") -> TableNextColumn() -> Text("Hello 1") // OK + // TableNextColumn() -> Text("Hello 0") -> TableNextColumn() -> Text("Hello 1") // OK: TableNextColumn() automatically gets to next row! + // TableNextRow() -> Text("Hello 0") // Not OK! Missing TableSetColumnIndex() or TableNextColumn()! Text will not appear! + // -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- + // - 5. Call EndTable() + IMGUI_API bool BeginTable(const char* str_id, int column, ImGuiTableFlags flags = 0, const ImVec2& outer_size = ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f), float inner_width = 0.0f); + IMGUI_API void EndTable(); // only call EndTable() if BeginTable() returns true! + IMGUI_API void TableNextRow(ImGuiTableRowFlags row_flags = 0, float min_row_height = 0.0f); // append into the first cell of a new row. + IMGUI_API bool TableNextColumn(); // append into the next column (or first column of next row if currently in last column). Return true when column is visible. + IMGUI_API bool TableSetColumnIndex(int column_n); // append into the specified column. Return true when column is visible. + + // Tables: Headers & Columns declaration + // - Use TableSetupColumn() to specify label, resizing policy, default width/weight, id, various other flags etc. + // - Use TableHeadersRow() to create a header row and automatically submit a TableHeader() for each column. + // Headers are required to perform: reordering, sorting, and opening the context menu. + // The context menu can also be made available in columns body using ImGuiTableFlags_ContextMenuInBody. + // - You may manually submit headers using TableNextRow() + TableHeader() calls, but this is only useful in + // some advanced use cases (e.g. adding custom widgets in header row). + // - Use TableSetupScrollFreeze() to lock columns/rows so they stay visible when scrolled. + IMGUI_API void TableSetupColumn(const char* label, ImGuiTableColumnFlags flags = 0, float init_width_or_weight = 0.0f, ImGuiID user_id = 0); + IMGUI_API void TableSetupScrollFreeze(int cols, int rows); // lock columns/rows so they stay visible when scrolled. + IMGUI_API void TableHeadersRow(); // submit all headers cells based on data provided to TableSetupColumn() + submit context menu + IMGUI_API void TableHeader(const char* label); // submit one header cell manually (rarely used) + + // Tables: Sorting + // - Call TableGetSortSpecs() to retrieve latest sort specs for the table. NULL when not sorting. + // - When 'SpecsDirty == true' you should sort your data. It will be true when sorting specs have changed + // since last call, or the first time. Make sure to set 'SpecsDirty = false' after sorting, else you may + // wastefully sort your data every frame! + // - Lifetime: don't hold on this pointer over multiple frames or past any subsequent call to BeginTable(). + IMGUI_API ImGuiTableSortSpecs* TableGetSortSpecs(); // get latest sort specs for the table (NULL if not sorting). + + // Tables: Miscellaneous functions + // - Functions args 'int column_n' treat the default value of -1 as the same as passing the current column index. + IMGUI_API int TableGetColumnCount(); // return number of columns (value passed to BeginTable) + IMGUI_API int TableGetColumnIndex(); // return current column index. + IMGUI_API int TableGetRowIndex(); // return current row index. + IMGUI_API const char* TableGetColumnName(int column_n = -1); // return "" if column didn't have a name declared by TableSetupColumn(). Pass -1 to use current column. + IMGUI_API ImGuiTableColumnFlags TableGetColumnFlags(int column_n = -1); // return column flags so you can query their Enabled/Visible/Sorted/Hovered status flags. Pass -1 to use current column. + IMGUI_API void TableSetColumnEnabled(int column_n, bool v);// change user accessible enabled/disabled state of a column. Set to false to hide the column. User can use the context menu to change this themselves (right-click in headers, or right-click in columns body with ImGuiTableFlags_ContextMenuInBody) + IMGUI_API void TableSetBgColor(ImGuiTableBgTarget target, ImU32 color, int column_n = -1); // change the color of a cell, row, or column. See ImGuiTableBgTarget_ flags for details. + + // Legacy Columns API (prefer using Tables!) + // - You can also use SameLine(pos_x) to mimic simplified columns. + IMGUI_API void Columns(int count = 1, const char* id = NULL, bool border = true); + IMGUI_API void NextColumn(); // next column, defaults to current row or next row if the current row is finished + IMGUI_API int GetColumnIndex(); // get current column index + IMGUI_API float GetColumnWidth(int column_index = -1); // get column width (in pixels). pass -1 to use current column + IMGUI_API void SetColumnWidth(int column_index, float width); // set column width (in pixels). pass -1 to use current column + IMGUI_API float GetColumnOffset(int column_index = -1); // get position of column line (in pixels, from the left side of the contents region). pass -1 to use current column, otherwise 0..GetColumnsCount() inclusive. column 0 is typically 0.0f + IMGUI_API void SetColumnOffset(int column_index, float offset_x); // set position of column line (in pixels, from the left side of the contents region). pass -1 to use current column + IMGUI_API int GetColumnsCount(); + + // Tab Bars, Tabs + IMGUI_API bool BeginTabBar(const char* str_id, ImGuiTabBarFlags flags = 0); // create and append into a TabBar + IMGUI_API void EndTabBar(); // only call EndTabBar() if BeginTabBar() returns true! + IMGUI_API bool BeginTabItem(const char* label, bool* p_open = NULL, ImGuiTabItemFlags flags = 0); // create a Tab. Returns true if the Tab is selected. + IMGUI_API void EndTabItem(); // only call EndTabItem() if BeginTabItem() returns true! + IMGUI_API bool TabItemButton(const char* label, ImGuiTabItemFlags flags = 0); // create a Tab behaving like a button. return true when clicked. cannot be selected in the tab bar. + IMGUI_API void SetTabItemClosed(const char* tab_or_docked_window_label); // notify TabBar or Docking system of a closed tab/window ahead (useful to reduce visual flicker on reorderable tab bars). For tab-bar: call after BeginTabBar() and before Tab submissions. Otherwise call with a window name. + + // Logging/Capture + // - All text output from the interface can be captured into tty/file/clipboard. By default, tree nodes are automatically opened during logging. + IMGUI_API void LogToTTY(int auto_open_depth = -1); // start logging to tty (stdout) + IMGUI_API void LogToFile(int auto_open_depth = -1, const char* filename = NULL); // start logging to file + IMGUI_API void LogToClipboard(int auto_open_depth = -1); // start logging to OS clipboard + IMGUI_API void LogFinish(); // stop logging (close file, etc.) + IMGUI_API void LogButtons(); // helper to display buttons for logging to tty/file/clipboard + IMGUI_API void LogText(const char* fmt, ...) IM_FMTARGS(1); // pass text data straight to log (without being displayed) + IMGUI_API void LogTextV(const char* fmt, va_list args) IM_FMTLIST(1); + + // Drag and Drop + // - On source items, call BeginDragDropSource(), if it returns true also call SetDragDropPayload() + EndDragDropSource(). + // - On target candidates, call BeginDragDropTarget(), if it returns true also call AcceptDragDropPayload() + EndDragDropTarget(). + // - If you stop calling BeginDragDropSource() the payload is preserved however it won't have a preview tooltip (we currently display a fallback "..." tooltip, see #1725) + // - An item can be both drag source and drop target. + IMGUI_API bool BeginDragDropSource(ImGuiDragDropFlags flags = 0); // call after submitting an item which may be dragged. when this return true, you can call SetDragDropPayload() + EndDragDropSource() + IMGUI_API bool SetDragDropPayload(const char* type, const void* data, size_t sz, ImGuiCond cond = 0); // type is a user defined string of maximum 32 characters. Strings starting with '_' are reserved for dear imgui internal types. Data is copied and held by imgui. + IMGUI_API void EndDragDropSource(); // only call EndDragDropSource() if BeginDragDropSource() returns true! + IMGUI_API bool BeginDragDropTarget(); // call after submitting an item that may receive a payload. If this returns true, you can call AcceptDragDropPayload() + EndDragDropTarget() + IMGUI_API const ImGuiPayload* AcceptDragDropPayload(const char* type, ImGuiDragDropFlags flags = 0); // accept contents of a given type. If ImGuiDragDropFlags_AcceptBeforeDelivery is set you can peek into the payload before the mouse button is released. + IMGUI_API void EndDragDropTarget(); // only call EndDragDropTarget() if BeginDragDropTarget() returns true! + IMGUI_API const ImGuiPayload* GetDragDropPayload(); // peek directly into the current payload from anywhere. may return NULL. use ImGuiPayload::IsDataType() to test for the payload type. + + // Disabling [BETA API] + // - Disable all user interactions and dim items visuals (applying style.DisabledAlpha over current colors) + // - BeginDisabled(false) essentially does nothing useful but is provided to facilitate use of boolean expressions. If you can avoid calling BeginDisabled(False)/EndDisabled() best to avoid it. + IMGUI_API void BeginDisabled(bool disabled = true); + IMGUI_API void EndDisabled(); + + // Clipping + // - Mouse hovering is affected by ImGui::PushClipRect() calls, unlike direct calls to ImDrawList::PushClipRect() which are render only. + IMGUI_API void PushClipRect(const ImVec2& clip_rect_min, const ImVec2& clip_rect_max, bool intersect_with_current_clip_rect); + IMGUI_API void PopClipRect(); + + // Focus, Activation + // - Prefer using "SetItemDefaultFocus()" over "if (IsWindowAppearing()) SetScrollHereY()" when applicable to signify "this is the default item" + IMGUI_API void SetItemDefaultFocus(); // make last item the default focused item of a window. + IMGUI_API void SetKeyboardFocusHere(int offset = 0); // focus keyboard on the next widget. Use positive 'offset' to access sub components of a multiple component widget. Use -1 to access previous widget. + + // Item/Widgets Utilities and Query Functions + // - Most of the functions are referring to the previous Item that has been submitted. + // - See Demo Window under "Widgets->Querying Status" for an interactive visualization of most of those functions. + IMGUI_API bool IsItemHovered(ImGuiHoveredFlags flags = 0); // is the last item hovered? (and usable, aka not blocked by a popup, etc.). See ImGuiHoveredFlags for more options. + IMGUI_API bool IsItemActive(); // is the last item active? (e.g. button being held, text field being edited. This will continuously return true while holding mouse button on an item. Items that don't interact will always return false) + IMGUI_API bool IsItemFocused(); // is the last item focused for keyboard/gamepad navigation? + IMGUI_API bool IsItemClicked(ImGuiMouseButton mouse_button = 0); // is the last item hovered and mouse clicked on? (**) == IsMouseClicked(mouse_button) && IsItemHovered()Important. (**) this it NOT equivalent to the behavior of e.g. Button(). Read comments in function definition. + IMGUI_API bool IsItemVisible(); // is the last item visible? (items may be out of sight because of clipping/scrolling) + IMGUI_API bool IsItemEdited(); // did the last item modify its underlying value this frame? or was pressed? This is generally the same as the "bool" return value of many widgets. + IMGUI_API bool IsItemActivated(); // was the last item just made active (item was previously inactive). + IMGUI_API bool IsItemDeactivated(); // was the last item just made inactive (item was previously active). Useful for Undo/Redo patterns with widgets that requires continuous editing. + IMGUI_API bool IsItemDeactivatedAfterEdit(); // was the last item just made inactive and made a value change when it was active? (e.g. Slider/Drag moved). Useful for Undo/Redo patterns with widgets that requires continuous editing. Note that you may get false positives (some widgets such as Combo()/ListBox()/Selectable() will return true even when clicking an already selected item). + IMGUI_API bool IsItemToggledOpen(); // was the last item open state toggled? set by TreeNode(). + IMGUI_API bool IsAnyItemHovered(); // is any item hovered? + IMGUI_API bool IsAnyItemActive(); // is any item active? + IMGUI_API bool IsAnyItemFocused(); // is any item focused? + IMGUI_API ImVec2 GetItemRectMin(); // get upper-left bounding rectangle of the last item (screen space) + IMGUI_API ImVec2 GetItemRectMax(); // get lower-right bounding rectangle of the last item (screen space) + IMGUI_API ImVec2 GetItemRectSize(); // get size of last item + IMGUI_API void SetItemAllowOverlap(); // allow last item to be overlapped by a subsequent item. sometimes useful with invisible buttons, selectables, etc. to catch unused area. + + // Viewports + // - Currently represents the Platform Window created by the application which is hosting our Dear ImGui windows. + // - In 'docking' branch with multi-viewport enabled, we extend this concept to have multiple active viewports. + // - In the future we will extend this concept further to also represent Platform Monitor and support a "no main platform window" operation mode. + IMGUI_API ImGuiViewport* GetMainViewport(); // return primary/default viewport. This can never be NULL. + + // Miscellaneous Utilities + IMGUI_API bool IsRectVisible(const ImVec2& size); // test if rectangle (of given size, starting from cursor position) is visible / not clipped. + IMGUI_API bool IsRectVisible(const ImVec2& rect_min, const ImVec2& rect_max); // test if rectangle (in screen space) is visible / not clipped. to perform coarse clipping on user's side. + IMGUI_API double GetTime(); // get global imgui time. incremented by io.DeltaTime every frame. + IMGUI_API int GetFrameCount(); // get global imgui frame count. incremented by 1 every frame. + IMGUI_API ImDrawList* GetBackgroundDrawList(); // this draw list will be the first rendering one. Useful to quickly draw shapes/text behind dear imgui contents. + IMGUI_API ImDrawList* GetForegroundDrawList(); // this draw list will be the last rendered one. Useful to quickly draw shapes/text over dear imgui contents. + IMGUI_API ImDrawListSharedData* GetDrawListSharedData(); // you may use this when creating your own ImDrawList instances. + IMGUI_API const char* GetStyleColorName(ImGuiCol idx); // get a string corresponding to the enum value (for display, saving, etc.). + IMGUI_API void SetStateStorage(ImGuiStorage* storage); // replace current window storage with our own (if you want to manipulate it yourself, typically clear subsection of it) + IMGUI_API ImGuiStorage* GetStateStorage(); + IMGUI_API void CalcListClipping(int items_count, float items_height, int* out_items_display_start, int* out_items_display_end); // calculate coarse clipping for large list of evenly sized items. Prefer using the ImGuiListClipper higher-level helper if you can. + IMGUI_API bool BeginChildFrame(ImGuiID id, const ImVec2& size, ImGuiWindowFlags flags = 0); // helper to create a child window / scrolling region that looks like a normal widget frame + IMGUI_API void EndChildFrame(); // always call EndChildFrame() regardless of BeginChildFrame() return values (which indicates a collapsed/clipped window) + + // Text Utilities + IMGUI_API ImVec2 CalcTextSize(const char* text, const char* text_end = NULL, bool hide_text_after_double_hash = false, float wrap_width = -1.0f); + + // Color Utilities + IMGUI_API ImVec4 ColorConvertU32ToFloat4(ImU32 in); + IMGUI_API ImU32 ColorConvertFloat4ToU32(const ImVec4& in); + IMGUI_API void ColorConvertRGBtoHSV(float r, float g, float b, float& out_h, float& out_s, float& out_v); + IMGUI_API void ColorConvertHSVtoRGB(float h, float s, float v, float& out_r, float& out_g, float& out_b); + + // Inputs Utilities: Keyboard + // - For 'int user_key_index' you can use your own indices/enums according to how your backend/engine stored them in io.KeysDown[]. + // - We don't know the meaning of those value. You can use GetKeyIndex() to map a ImGuiKey_ value into the user index. + IMGUI_API int GetKeyIndex(ImGuiKey imgui_key); // map ImGuiKey_* values into user's key index. == io.KeyMap[key] + IMGUI_API bool IsKeyDown(int user_key_index); // is key being held. == io.KeysDown[user_key_index]. + IMGUI_API bool IsKeyPressed(int user_key_index, bool repeat = true); // was key pressed (went from !Down to Down)? if repeat=true, uses io.KeyRepeatDelay / KeyRepeatRate + IMGUI_API bool IsKeyReleased(int user_key_index); // was key released (went from Down to !Down)? + IMGUI_API int GetKeyPressedAmount(int key_index, float repeat_delay, float rate); // uses provided repeat rate/delay. return a count, most often 0 or 1 but might be >1 if RepeatRate is small enough that DeltaTime > RepeatRate + IMGUI_API void CaptureKeyboardFromApp(bool want_capture_keyboard_value = true); // attention: misleading name! manually override io.WantCaptureKeyboard flag next frame (said flag is entirely left for your application to handle). e.g. force capture keyboard when your widget is being hovered. This is equivalent to setting "io.WantCaptureKeyboard = want_capture_keyboard_value"; after the next NewFrame() call. + + // Inputs Utilities: Mouse + // - To refer to a mouse button, you may use named enums in your code e.g. ImGuiMouseButton_Left, ImGuiMouseButton_Right. + // - You can also use regular integer: it is forever guaranteed that 0=Left, 1=Right, 2=Middle. + // - Dragging operations are only reported after mouse has moved a certain distance away from the initial clicking position (see 'lock_threshold' and 'io.MouseDraggingThreshold') + IMGUI_API bool IsMouseDown(ImGuiMouseButton button); // is mouse button held? + IMGUI_API bool IsMouseClicked(ImGuiMouseButton button, bool repeat = false); // did mouse button clicked? (went from !Down to Down) + IMGUI_API bool IsMouseReleased(ImGuiMouseButton button); // did mouse button released? (went from Down to !Down) + IMGUI_API bool IsMouseDoubleClicked(ImGuiMouseButton button); // did mouse button double-clicked? (note that a double-click will also report IsMouseClicked() == true) + IMGUI_API bool IsMouseHoveringRect(const ImVec2& r_min, const ImVec2& r_max, bool clip = true);// is mouse hovering given bounding rect (in screen space). clipped by current clipping settings, but disregarding of other consideration of focus/window ordering/popup-block. + IMGUI_API bool IsMousePosValid(const ImVec2* mouse_pos = NULL); // by convention we use (-FLT_MAX,-FLT_MAX) to denote that there is no mouse available + IMGUI_API bool IsAnyMouseDown(); // is any mouse button held? + IMGUI_API ImVec2 GetMousePos(); // shortcut to ImGui::GetIO().MousePos provided by user, to be consistent with other calls + IMGUI_API ImVec2 GetMousePosOnOpeningCurrentPopup(); // retrieve mouse position at the time of opening popup we have BeginPopup() into (helper to avoid user backing that value themselves) + IMGUI_API bool IsMouseDragging(ImGuiMouseButton button, float lock_threshold = -1.0f); // is mouse dragging? (if lock_threshold < -1.0f, uses io.MouseDraggingThreshold) + IMGUI_API ImVec2 GetMouseDragDelta(ImGuiMouseButton button = 0, float lock_threshold = -1.0f); // return the delta from the initial clicking position while the mouse button is pressed or was just released. This is locked and return 0.0f until the mouse moves past a distance threshold at least once (if lock_threshold < -1.0f, uses io.MouseDraggingThreshold) + IMGUI_API void ResetMouseDragDelta(ImGuiMouseButton button = 0); // + IMGUI_API ImGuiMouseCursor GetMouseCursor(); // get desired cursor type, reset in ImGui::NewFrame(), this is updated during the frame. valid before Render(). If you use software rendering by setting io.MouseDrawCursor ImGui will render those for you + IMGUI_API void SetMouseCursor(ImGuiMouseCursor cursor_type); // set desired cursor type + IMGUI_API void CaptureMouseFromApp(bool want_capture_mouse_value = true); // attention: misleading name! manually override io.WantCaptureMouse flag next frame (said flag is entirely left for your application to handle). This is equivalent to setting "io.WantCaptureMouse = want_capture_mouse_value;" after the next NewFrame() call. + + // Clipboard Utilities + // - Also see the LogToClipboard() function to capture GUI into clipboard, or easily output text data to the clipboard. + IMGUI_API const char* GetClipboardText(); + IMGUI_API void SetClipboardText(const char* text); + + // Settings/.Ini Utilities + // - The disk functions are automatically called if io.IniFilename != NULL (default is "imgui.ini"). + // - Set io.IniFilename to NULL to load/save manually. Read io.WantSaveIniSettings description about handling .ini saving manually. + // - Important: default value "imgui.ini" is relative to current working dir! Most apps will want to lock this to an absolute path (e.g. same path as executables). + IMGUI_API void LoadIniSettingsFromDisk(const char* ini_filename); // call after CreateContext() and before the first call to NewFrame(). NewFrame() automatically calls LoadIniSettingsFromDisk(io.IniFilename). + IMGUI_API void LoadIniSettingsFromMemory(const char* ini_data, size_t ini_size=0); // call after CreateContext() and before the first call to NewFrame() to provide .ini data from your own data source. + IMGUI_API void SaveIniSettingsToDisk(const char* ini_filename); // this is automatically called (if io.IniFilename is not empty) a few seconds after any modification that should be reflected in the .ini file (and also by DestroyContext). + IMGUI_API const char* SaveIniSettingsToMemory(size_t* out_ini_size = NULL); // return a zero-terminated string with the .ini data which you can save by your own mean. call when io.WantSaveIniSettings is set, then save data by your own mean and clear io.WantSaveIniSettings. + + // Debug Utilities + // - This is used by the IMGUI_CHECKVERSION() macro. + IMGUI_API bool DebugCheckVersionAndDataLayout(const char* version_str, size_t sz_io, size_t sz_style, size_t sz_vec2, size_t sz_vec4, size_t sz_drawvert, size_t sz_drawidx); // This is called by IMGUI_CHECKVERSION() macro. + + // Memory Allocators + // - Those functions are not reliant on the current context. + // - DLL users: heaps and globals are not shared across DLL boundaries! You will need to call SetCurrentContext() + SetAllocatorFunctions() + // for each static/DLL boundary you are calling from. Read "Context and Memory Allocators" section of imgui.cpp for more details. + IMGUI_API void SetAllocatorFunctions(ImGuiMemAllocFunc alloc_func, ImGuiMemFreeFunc free_func, void* user_data = NULL); + IMGUI_API void GetAllocatorFunctions(ImGuiMemAllocFunc* p_alloc_func, ImGuiMemFreeFunc* p_free_func, void** p_user_data); + IMGUI_API void* MemAlloc(size_t size); + IMGUI_API void MemFree(void* ptr); + +} // namespace ImGui + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Flags & Enumerations +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// Flags for ImGui::Begin() +enum ImGuiWindowFlags_ +{ + ImGuiWindowFlags_None = 0, + ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar = 1 << 0, // Disable title-bar + ImGuiWindowFlags_NoResize = 1 << 1, // Disable user resizing with the lower-right grip + ImGuiWindowFlags_NoMove = 1 << 2, // Disable user moving the window + ImGuiWindowFlags_NoScrollbar = 1 << 3, // Disable scrollbars (window can still scroll with mouse or programmatically) + ImGuiWindowFlags_NoScrollWithMouse = 1 << 4, // Disable user vertically scrolling with mouse wheel. On child window, mouse wheel will be forwarded to the parent unless NoScrollbar is also set. + ImGuiWindowFlags_NoCollapse = 1 << 5, // Disable user collapsing window by double-clicking on it + ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize = 1 << 6, // Resize every window to its content every frame + ImGuiWindowFlags_NoBackground = 1 << 7, // Disable drawing background color (WindowBg, etc.) and outside border. Similar as using SetNextWindowBgAlpha(0.0f). + ImGuiWindowFlags_NoSavedSettings = 1 << 8, // Never load/save settings in .ini file + ImGuiWindowFlags_NoMouseInputs = 1 << 9, // Disable catching mouse, hovering test with pass through. + ImGuiWindowFlags_MenuBar = 1 << 10, // Has a menu-bar + ImGuiWindowFlags_HorizontalScrollbar = 1 << 11, // Allow horizontal scrollbar to appear (off by default). You may use SetNextWindowContentSize(ImVec2(width,0.0f)); prior to calling Begin() to specify width. Read code in imgui_demo in the "Horizontal Scrolling" section. + ImGuiWindowFlags_NoFocusOnAppearing = 1 << 12, // Disable taking focus when transitioning from hidden to visible state + ImGuiWindowFlags_NoBringToFrontOnFocus = 1 << 13, // Disable bringing window to front when taking focus (e.g. clicking on it or programmatically giving it focus) + ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysVerticalScrollbar= 1 << 14, // Always show vertical scrollbar (even if ContentSize.y < Size.y) + ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysHorizontalScrollbar=1<< 15, // Always show horizontal scrollbar (even if ContentSize.x < Size.x) + ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysUseWindowPadding = 1 << 16, // Ensure child windows without border uses style.WindowPadding (ignored by default for non-bordered child windows, because more convenient) + ImGuiWindowFlags_NoNavInputs = 1 << 18, // No gamepad/keyboard navigation within the window + ImGuiWindowFlags_NoNavFocus = 1 << 19, // No focusing toward this window with gamepad/keyboard navigation (e.g. skipped by CTRL+TAB) + ImGuiWindowFlags_UnsavedDocument = 1 << 20, // Display a dot next to the title. When used in a tab/docking context, tab is selected when clicking the X + closure is not assumed (will wait for user to stop submitting the tab). Otherwise closure is assumed when pressing the X, so if you keep submitting the tab may reappear at end of tab bar. + ImGuiWindowFlags_NoNav = ImGuiWindowFlags_NoNavInputs | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoNavFocus, + ImGuiWindowFlags_NoDecoration = ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoResize | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoScrollbar | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoCollapse, + ImGuiWindowFlags_NoInputs = ImGuiWindowFlags_NoMouseInputs | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoNavInputs | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoNavFocus, + + // [Internal] + ImGuiWindowFlags_NavFlattened = 1 << 23, // [BETA] Allow gamepad/keyboard navigation to cross over parent border to this child (only use on child that have no scrolling!) + ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow = 1 << 24, // Don't use! For internal use by BeginChild() + ImGuiWindowFlags_Tooltip = 1 << 25, // Don't use! For internal use by BeginTooltip() + ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup = 1 << 26, // Don't use! For internal use by BeginPopup() + ImGuiWindowFlags_Modal = 1 << 27, // Don't use! For internal use by BeginPopupModal() + ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildMenu = 1 << 28 // Don't use! For internal use by BeginMenu() + + // [Obsolete] + //ImGuiWindowFlags_ResizeFromAnySide = 1 << 17, // --> Set io.ConfigWindowsResizeFromEdges=true and make sure mouse cursors are supported by backend (io.BackendFlags & ImGuiBackendFlags_HasMouseCursors) +}; + +// Flags for ImGui::InputText() +enum ImGuiInputTextFlags_ +{ + ImGuiInputTextFlags_None = 0, + ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsDecimal = 1 << 0, // Allow 0123456789.+-*/ + ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsHexadecimal = 1 << 1, // Allow 0123456789ABCDEFabcdef + ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsUppercase = 1 << 2, // Turn a..z into A..Z + ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsNoBlank = 1 << 3, // Filter out spaces, tabs + ImGuiInputTextFlags_AutoSelectAll = 1 << 4, // Select entire text when first taking mouse focus + ImGuiInputTextFlags_EnterReturnsTrue = 1 << 5, // Return 'true' when Enter is pressed (as opposed to every time the value was modified). Consider looking at the IsItemDeactivatedAfterEdit() function. + ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackCompletion = 1 << 6, // Callback on pressing TAB (for completion handling) + ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackHistory = 1 << 7, // Callback on pressing Up/Down arrows (for history handling) + ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackAlways = 1 << 8, // Callback on each iteration. User code may query cursor position, modify text buffer. + ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackCharFilter = 1 << 9, // Callback on character inputs to replace or discard them. Modify 'EventChar' to replace or discard, or return 1 in callback to discard. + ImGuiInputTextFlags_AllowTabInput = 1 << 10, // Pressing TAB input a '\t' character into the text field + ImGuiInputTextFlags_CtrlEnterForNewLine = 1 << 11, // In multi-line mode, unfocus with Enter, add new line with Ctrl+Enter (default is opposite: unfocus with Ctrl+Enter, add line with Enter). + ImGuiInputTextFlags_NoHorizontalScroll = 1 << 12, // Disable following the cursor horizontally + ImGuiInputTextFlags_AlwaysOverwrite = 1 << 13, // Overwrite mode + ImGuiInputTextFlags_ReadOnly = 1 << 14, // Read-only mode + ImGuiInputTextFlags_Password = 1 << 15, // Password mode, display all characters as '*' + ImGuiInputTextFlags_NoUndoRedo = 1 << 16, // Disable undo/redo. Note that input text owns the text data while active, if you want to provide your own undo/redo stack you need e.g. to call ClearActiveID(). + ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsScientific = 1 << 17, // Allow 0123456789.+-*/eE (Scientific notation input) + ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackResize = 1 << 18, // Callback on buffer capacity changes request (beyond 'buf_size' parameter value), allowing the string to grow. Notify when the string wants to be resized (for string types which hold a cache of their Size). You will be provided a new BufSize in the callback and NEED to honor it. (see misc/cpp/imgui_stdlib.h for an example of using this) + ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackEdit = 1 << 19 // Callback on any edit (note that InputText() already returns true on edit, the callback is useful mainly to manipulate the underlying buffer while focus is active) + + // Obsolete names (will be removed soon) +#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_OBSOLETE_FUNCTIONS + , ImGuiInputTextFlags_AlwaysInsertMode = ImGuiInputTextFlags_AlwaysOverwrite // [renamed in 1.82] name was not matching behavior +#endif +}; + +// Flags for ImGui::TreeNodeEx(), ImGui::CollapsingHeader*() +enum ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_ +{ + ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_None = 0, + ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Selected = 1 << 0, // Draw as selected + ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Framed = 1 << 1, // Draw frame with background (e.g. for CollapsingHeader) + ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_AllowItemOverlap = 1 << 2, // Hit testing to allow subsequent widgets to overlap this one + ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NoTreePushOnOpen = 1 << 3, // Don't do a TreePush() when open (e.g. for CollapsingHeader) = no extra indent nor pushing on ID stack + ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NoAutoOpenOnLog = 1 << 4, // Don't automatically and temporarily open node when Logging is active (by default logging will automatically open tree nodes) + ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_DefaultOpen = 1 << 5, // Default node to be open + ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_OpenOnDoubleClick = 1 << 6, // Need double-click to open node + ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_OpenOnArrow = 1 << 7, // Only open when clicking on the arrow part. If ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_OpenOnDoubleClick is also set, single-click arrow or double-click all box to open. + ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Leaf = 1 << 8, // No collapsing, no arrow (use as a convenience for leaf nodes). + ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Bullet = 1 << 9, // Display a bullet instead of arrow + ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_FramePadding = 1 << 10, // Use FramePadding (even for an unframed text node) to vertically align text baseline to regular widget height. Equivalent to calling AlignTextToFramePadding(). + ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_SpanAvailWidth = 1 << 11, // Extend hit box to the right-most edge, even if not framed. This is not the default in order to allow adding other items on the same line. In the future we may refactor the hit system to be front-to-back, allowing natural overlaps and then this can become the default. + ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_SpanFullWidth = 1 << 12, // Extend hit box to the left-most and right-most edges (bypass the indented area). + ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NavLeftJumpsBackHere = 1 << 13, // (WIP) Nav: left direction may move to this TreeNode() from any of its child (items submitted between TreeNode and TreePop) + //ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NoScrollOnOpen = 1 << 14, // FIXME: TODO: Disable automatic scroll on TreePop() if node got just open and contents is not visible + ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_CollapsingHeader = ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Framed | ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NoTreePushOnOpen | ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NoAutoOpenOnLog +}; + +// Flags for OpenPopup*(), BeginPopupContext*(), IsPopupOpen() functions. +// - To be backward compatible with older API which took an 'int mouse_button = 1' argument, we need to treat +// small flags values as a mouse button index, so we encode the mouse button in the first few bits of the flags. +// It is therefore guaranteed to be legal to pass a mouse button index in ImGuiPopupFlags. +// - For the same reason, we exceptionally default the ImGuiPopupFlags argument of BeginPopupContextXXX functions to 1 instead of 0. +// IMPORTANT: because the default parameter is 1 (==ImGuiPopupFlags_MouseButtonRight), if you rely on the default parameter +// and want to another another flag, you need to pass in the ImGuiPopupFlags_MouseButtonRight flag. +// - Multiple buttons currently cannot be combined/or-ed in those functions (we could allow it later). +enum ImGuiPopupFlags_ +{ + ImGuiPopupFlags_None = 0, + ImGuiPopupFlags_MouseButtonLeft = 0, // For BeginPopupContext*(): open on Left Mouse release. Guaranteed to always be == 0 (same as ImGuiMouseButton_Left) + ImGuiPopupFlags_MouseButtonRight = 1, // For BeginPopupContext*(): open on Right Mouse release. Guaranteed to always be == 1 (same as ImGuiMouseButton_Right) + ImGuiPopupFlags_MouseButtonMiddle = 2, // For BeginPopupContext*(): open on Middle Mouse release. Guaranteed to always be == 2 (same as ImGuiMouseButton_Middle) + ImGuiPopupFlags_MouseButtonMask_ = 0x1F, + ImGuiPopupFlags_MouseButtonDefault_ = 1, + ImGuiPopupFlags_NoOpenOverExistingPopup = 1 << 5, // For OpenPopup*(), BeginPopupContext*(): don't open if there's already a popup at the same level of the popup stack + ImGuiPopupFlags_NoOpenOverItems = 1 << 6, // For BeginPopupContextWindow(): don't return true when hovering items, only when hovering empty space + ImGuiPopupFlags_AnyPopupId = 1 << 7, // For IsPopupOpen(): ignore the ImGuiID parameter and test for any popup. + ImGuiPopupFlags_AnyPopupLevel = 1 << 8, // For IsPopupOpen(): search/test at any level of the popup stack (default test in the current level) + ImGuiPopupFlags_AnyPopup = ImGuiPopupFlags_AnyPopupId | ImGuiPopupFlags_AnyPopupLevel +}; + +// Flags for ImGui::Selectable() +enum ImGuiSelectableFlags_ +{ + ImGuiSelectableFlags_None = 0, + ImGuiSelectableFlags_DontClosePopups = 1 << 0, // Clicking this don't close parent popup window + ImGuiSelectableFlags_SpanAllColumns = 1 << 1, // Selectable frame can span all columns (text will still fit in current column) + ImGuiSelectableFlags_AllowDoubleClick = 1 << 2, // Generate press events on double clicks too + ImGuiSelectableFlags_Disabled = 1 << 3, // Cannot be selected, display grayed out text + ImGuiSelectableFlags_AllowItemOverlap = 1 << 4 // (WIP) Hit testing to allow subsequent widgets to overlap this one +}; + +// Flags for ImGui::BeginCombo() +enum ImGuiComboFlags_ +{ + ImGuiComboFlags_None = 0, + ImGuiComboFlags_PopupAlignLeft = 1 << 0, // Align the popup toward the left by default + ImGuiComboFlags_HeightSmall = 1 << 1, // Max ~4 items visible. Tip: If you want your combo popup to be a specific size you can use SetNextWindowSizeConstraints() prior to calling BeginCombo() + ImGuiComboFlags_HeightRegular = 1 << 2, // Max ~8 items visible (default) + ImGuiComboFlags_HeightLarge = 1 << 3, // Max ~20 items visible + ImGuiComboFlags_HeightLargest = 1 << 4, // As many fitting items as possible + ImGuiComboFlags_NoArrowButton = 1 << 5, // Display on the preview box without the square arrow button + ImGuiComboFlags_NoPreview = 1 << 6, // Display only a square arrow button + ImGuiComboFlags_HeightMask_ = ImGuiComboFlags_HeightSmall | ImGuiComboFlags_HeightRegular | ImGuiComboFlags_HeightLarge | ImGuiComboFlags_HeightLargest +}; + +// Flags for ImGui::BeginTabBar() +enum ImGuiTabBarFlags_ +{ + ImGuiTabBarFlags_None = 0, + ImGuiTabBarFlags_Reorderable = 1 << 0, // Allow manually dragging tabs to re-order them + New tabs are appended at the end of list + ImGuiTabBarFlags_AutoSelectNewTabs = 1 << 1, // Automatically select new tabs when they appear + ImGuiTabBarFlags_TabListPopupButton = 1 << 2, // Disable buttons to open the tab list popup + ImGuiTabBarFlags_NoCloseWithMiddleMouseButton = 1 << 3, // Disable behavior of closing tabs (that are submitted with p_open != NULL) with middle mouse button. You can still repro this behavior on user's side with if (IsItemHovered() && IsMouseClicked(2)) *p_open = false. + ImGuiTabBarFlags_NoTabListScrollingButtons = 1 << 4, // Disable scrolling buttons (apply when fitting policy is ImGuiTabBarFlags_FittingPolicyScroll) + ImGuiTabBarFlags_NoTooltip = 1 << 5, // Disable tooltips when hovering a tab + ImGuiTabBarFlags_FittingPolicyResizeDown = 1 << 6, // Resize tabs when they don't fit + ImGuiTabBarFlags_FittingPolicyScroll = 1 << 7, // Add scroll buttons when tabs don't fit + ImGuiTabBarFlags_FittingPolicyMask_ = ImGuiTabBarFlags_FittingPolicyResizeDown | ImGuiTabBarFlags_FittingPolicyScroll, + ImGuiTabBarFlags_FittingPolicyDefault_ = ImGuiTabBarFlags_FittingPolicyResizeDown +}; + +// Flags for ImGui::BeginTabItem() +enum ImGuiTabItemFlags_ +{ + ImGuiTabItemFlags_None = 0, + ImGuiTabItemFlags_UnsavedDocument = 1 << 0, // Display a dot next to the title + tab is selected when clicking the X + closure is not assumed (will wait for user to stop submitting the tab). Otherwise closure is assumed when pressing the X, so if you keep submitting the tab may reappear at end of tab bar. + ImGuiTabItemFlags_SetSelected = 1 << 1, // Trigger flag to programmatically make the tab selected when calling BeginTabItem() + ImGuiTabItemFlags_NoCloseWithMiddleMouseButton = 1 << 2, // Disable behavior of closing tabs (that are submitted with p_open != NULL) with middle mouse button. You can still repro this behavior on user's side with if (IsItemHovered() && IsMouseClicked(2)) *p_open = false. + ImGuiTabItemFlags_NoPushId = 1 << 3, // Don't call PushID(tab->ID)/PopID() on BeginTabItem()/EndTabItem() + ImGuiTabItemFlags_NoTooltip = 1 << 4, // Disable tooltip for the given tab + ImGuiTabItemFlags_NoReorder = 1 << 5, // Disable reordering this tab or having another tab cross over this tab + ImGuiTabItemFlags_Leading = 1 << 6, // Enforce the tab position to the left of the tab bar (after the tab list popup button) + ImGuiTabItemFlags_Trailing = 1 << 7 // Enforce the tab position to the right of the tab bar (before the scrolling buttons) +}; + +// Flags for ImGui::BeginTable() +// [BETA API] API may evolve slightly! If you use this, please update to the next version when it comes out! +// - Important! Sizing policies have complex and subtle side effects, more so than you would expect. +// Read comments/demos carefully + experiment with live demos to get acquainted with them. +// - The DEFAULT sizing policies are: +// - Default to ImGuiTableFlags_SizingFixedFit if ScrollX is on, or if host window has ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize. +// - Default to ImGuiTableFlags_SizingStretchSame if ScrollX is off. +// - When ScrollX is off: +// - Table defaults to ImGuiTableFlags_SizingStretchSame -> all Columns defaults to ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthStretch with same weight. +// - Columns sizing policy allowed: Stretch (default), Fixed/Auto. +// - Fixed Columns will generally obtain their requested width (unless the table cannot fit them all). +// - Stretch Columns will share the remaining width. +// - Mixed Fixed/Stretch columns is possible but has various side-effects on resizing behaviors. +// The typical use of mixing sizing policies is: any number of LEADING Fixed columns, followed by one or two TRAILING Stretch columns. +// (this is because the visible order of columns have subtle but necessary effects on how they react to manual resizing). +// - When ScrollX is on: +// - Table defaults to ImGuiTableFlags_SizingFixedFit -> all Columns defaults to ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthFixed +// - Columns sizing policy allowed: Fixed/Auto mostly. +// - Fixed Columns can be enlarged as needed. Table will show an horizontal scrollbar if needed. +// - When using auto-resizing (non-resizable) fixed columns, querying the content width to use item right-alignment e.g. SetNextItemWidth(-FLT_MIN) doesn't make sense, would create a feedback loop. +// - Using Stretch columns OFTEN DOES NOT MAKE SENSE if ScrollX is on, UNLESS you have specified a value for 'inner_width' in BeginTable(). +// If you specify a value for 'inner_width' then effectively the scrolling space is known and Stretch or mixed Fixed/Stretch columns become meaningful again. +// - Read on documentation at the top of imgui_tables.cpp for details. +enum ImGuiTableFlags_ +{ + // Features + ImGuiTableFlags_None = 0, + ImGuiTableFlags_Resizable = 1 << 0, // Enable resizing columns. + ImGuiTableFlags_Reorderable = 1 << 1, // Enable reordering columns in header row (need calling TableSetupColumn() + TableHeadersRow() to display headers) + ImGuiTableFlags_Hideable = 1 << 2, // Enable hiding/disabling columns in context menu. + ImGuiTableFlags_Sortable = 1 << 3, // Enable sorting. Call TableGetSortSpecs() to obtain sort specs. Also see ImGuiTableFlags_SortMulti and ImGuiTableFlags_SortTristate. + ImGuiTableFlags_NoSavedSettings = 1 << 4, // Disable persisting columns order, width and sort settings in the .ini file. + ImGuiTableFlags_ContextMenuInBody = 1 << 5, // Right-click on columns body/contents will display table context menu. By default it is available in TableHeadersRow(). + // Decorations + ImGuiTableFlags_RowBg = 1 << 6, // Set each RowBg color with ImGuiCol_TableRowBg or ImGuiCol_TableRowBgAlt (equivalent of calling TableSetBgColor with ImGuiTableBgFlags_RowBg0 on each row manually) + ImGuiTableFlags_BordersInnerH = 1 << 7, // Draw horizontal borders between rows. + ImGuiTableFlags_BordersOuterH = 1 << 8, // Draw horizontal borders at the top and bottom. + ImGuiTableFlags_BordersInnerV = 1 << 9, // Draw vertical borders between columns. + ImGuiTableFlags_BordersOuterV = 1 << 10, // Draw vertical borders on the left and right sides. + ImGuiTableFlags_BordersH = ImGuiTableFlags_BordersInnerH | ImGuiTableFlags_BordersOuterH, // Draw horizontal borders. + ImGuiTableFlags_BordersV = ImGuiTableFlags_BordersInnerV | ImGuiTableFlags_BordersOuterV, // Draw vertical borders. + ImGuiTableFlags_BordersInner = ImGuiTableFlags_BordersInnerV | ImGuiTableFlags_BordersInnerH, // Draw inner borders. + ImGuiTableFlags_BordersOuter = ImGuiTableFlags_BordersOuterV | ImGuiTableFlags_BordersOuterH, // Draw outer borders. + ImGuiTableFlags_Borders = ImGuiTableFlags_BordersInner | ImGuiTableFlags_BordersOuter, // Draw all borders. + ImGuiTableFlags_NoBordersInBody = 1 << 11, // [ALPHA] Disable vertical borders in columns Body (borders will always appears in Headers). -> May move to style + ImGuiTableFlags_NoBordersInBodyUntilResize = 1 << 12, // [ALPHA] Disable vertical borders in columns Body until hovered for resize (borders will always appears in Headers). -> May move to style + // Sizing Policy (read above for defaults) + ImGuiTableFlags_SizingFixedFit = 1 << 13, // Columns default to _WidthFixed or _WidthAuto (if resizable or not resizable), matching contents width. + ImGuiTableFlags_SizingFixedSame = 2 << 13, // Columns default to _WidthFixed or _WidthAuto (if resizable or not resizable), matching the maximum contents width of all columns. Implicitly enable ImGuiTableFlags_NoKeepColumnsVisible. + ImGuiTableFlags_SizingStretchProp = 3 << 13, // Columns default to _WidthStretch with default weights proportional to each columns contents widths. + ImGuiTableFlags_SizingStretchSame = 4 << 13, // Columns default to _WidthStretch with default weights all equal, unless overridden by TableSetupColumn(). + // Sizing Extra Options + ImGuiTableFlags_NoHostExtendX = 1 << 16, // Make outer width auto-fit to columns, overriding outer_size.x value. Only available when ScrollX/ScrollY are disabled and Stretch columns are not used. + ImGuiTableFlags_NoHostExtendY = 1 << 17, // Make outer height stop exactly at outer_size.y (prevent auto-extending table past the limit). Only available when ScrollX/ScrollY are disabled. Data below the limit will be clipped and not visible. + ImGuiTableFlags_NoKeepColumnsVisible = 1 << 18, // Disable keeping column always minimally visible when ScrollX is off and table gets too small. Not recommended if columns are resizable. + ImGuiTableFlags_PreciseWidths = 1 << 19, // Disable distributing remainder width to stretched columns (width allocation on a 100-wide table with 3 columns: Without this flag: 33,33,34. With this flag: 33,33,33). With larger number of columns, resizing will appear to be less smooth. + // Clipping + ImGuiTableFlags_NoClip = 1 << 20, // Disable clipping rectangle for every individual columns (reduce draw command count, items will be able to overflow into other columns). Generally incompatible with TableSetupScrollFreeze(). + // Padding + ImGuiTableFlags_PadOuterX = 1 << 21, // Default if BordersOuterV is on. Enable outer-most padding. Generally desirable if you have headers. + ImGuiTableFlags_NoPadOuterX = 1 << 22, // Default if BordersOuterV is off. Disable outer-most padding. + ImGuiTableFlags_NoPadInnerX = 1 << 23, // Disable inner padding between columns (double inner padding if BordersOuterV is on, single inner padding if BordersOuterV is off). + // Scrolling + ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollX = 1 << 24, // Enable horizontal scrolling. Require 'outer_size' parameter of BeginTable() to specify the container size. Changes default sizing policy. Because this create a child window, ScrollY is currently generally recommended when using ScrollX. + ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollY = 1 << 25, // Enable vertical scrolling. Require 'outer_size' parameter of BeginTable() to specify the container size. + // Sorting + ImGuiTableFlags_SortMulti = 1 << 26, // Hold shift when clicking headers to sort on multiple column. TableGetSortSpecs() may return specs where (SpecsCount > 1). + ImGuiTableFlags_SortTristate = 1 << 27, // Allow no sorting, disable default sorting. TableGetSortSpecs() may return specs where (SpecsCount == 0). + + // [Internal] Combinations and masks + ImGuiTableFlags_SizingMask_ = ImGuiTableFlags_SizingFixedFit | ImGuiTableFlags_SizingFixedSame | ImGuiTableFlags_SizingStretchProp | ImGuiTableFlags_SizingStretchSame + + // Obsolete names (will be removed soon) +#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_OBSOLETE_FUNCTIONS + //, ImGuiTableFlags_ColumnsWidthFixed = ImGuiTableFlags_SizingFixedFit, ImGuiTableFlags_ColumnsWidthStretch = ImGuiTableFlags_SizingStretchSame // WIP Tables 2020/12 + //, ImGuiTableFlags_SizingPolicyFixed = ImGuiTableFlags_SizingFixedFit, ImGuiTableFlags_SizingPolicyStretch = ImGuiTableFlags_SizingStretchSame // WIP Tables 2021/01 +#endif +}; + +// Flags for ImGui::TableSetupColumn() +enum ImGuiTableColumnFlags_ +{ + // Input configuration flags + ImGuiTableColumnFlags_None = 0, + ImGuiTableColumnFlags_Disabled = 1 << 0, // Overriding/master disable flag: hide column, won't show in context menu (unlike calling TableSetColumnEnabled() which manipulates the user accessible state) + ImGuiTableColumnFlags_DefaultHide = 1 << 1, // Default as a hidden/disabled column. + ImGuiTableColumnFlags_DefaultSort = 1 << 2, // Default as a sorting column. + ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthStretch = 1 << 3, // Column will stretch. Preferable with horizontal scrolling disabled (default if table sizing policy is _SizingStretchSame or _SizingStretchProp). + ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthFixed = 1 << 4, // Column will not stretch. Preferable with horizontal scrolling enabled (default if table sizing policy is _SizingFixedFit and table is resizable). + ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoResize = 1 << 5, // Disable manual resizing. + ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoReorder = 1 << 6, // Disable manual reordering this column, this will also prevent other columns from crossing over this column. + ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoHide = 1 << 7, // Disable ability to hide/disable this column. + ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoClip = 1 << 8, // Disable clipping for this column (all NoClip columns will render in a same draw command). + ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoSort = 1 << 9, // Disable ability to sort on this field (even if ImGuiTableFlags_Sortable is set on the table). + ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoSortAscending = 1 << 10, // Disable ability to sort in the ascending direction. + ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoSortDescending = 1 << 11, // Disable ability to sort in the descending direction. + ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoHeaderLabel = 1 << 12, // TableHeadersRow() will not submit label for this column. Convenient for some small columns. Name will still appear in context menu. + ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoHeaderWidth = 1 << 13, // Disable header text width contribution to automatic column width. + ImGuiTableColumnFlags_PreferSortAscending = 1 << 14, // Make the initial sort direction Ascending when first sorting on this column (default). + ImGuiTableColumnFlags_PreferSortDescending = 1 << 15, // Make the initial sort direction Descending when first sorting on this column. + ImGuiTableColumnFlags_IndentEnable = 1 << 16, // Use current Indent value when entering cell (default for column 0). + ImGuiTableColumnFlags_IndentDisable = 1 << 17, // Ignore current Indent value when entering cell (default for columns > 0). Indentation changes _within_ the cell will still be honored. + + // Output status flags, read-only via TableGetColumnFlags() + ImGuiTableColumnFlags_IsEnabled = 1 << 24, // Status: is enabled == not hidden by user/api (referred to as "Hide" in _DefaultHide and _NoHide) flags. + ImGuiTableColumnFlags_IsVisible = 1 << 25, // Status: is visible == is enabled AND not clipped by scrolling. + ImGuiTableColumnFlags_IsSorted = 1 << 26, // Status: is currently part of the sort specs + ImGuiTableColumnFlags_IsHovered = 1 << 27, // Status: is hovered by mouse + + // [Internal] Combinations and masks + ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthMask_ = ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthStretch | ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthFixed, + ImGuiTableColumnFlags_IndentMask_ = ImGuiTableColumnFlags_IndentEnable | ImGuiTableColumnFlags_IndentDisable, + ImGuiTableColumnFlags_StatusMask_ = ImGuiTableColumnFlags_IsEnabled | ImGuiTableColumnFlags_IsVisible | ImGuiTableColumnFlags_IsSorted | ImGuiTableColumnFlags_IsHovered, + ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoDirectResize_ = 1 << 30 // [Internal] Disable user resizing this column directly (it may however we resized indirectly from its left edge) + + // Obsolete names (will be removed soon) +#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_OBSOLETE_FUNCTIONS + //ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthAuto = ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthFixed | ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoResize, // Column will not stretch and keep resizing based on submitted contents. +#endif +}; + +// Flags for ImGui::TableNextRow() +enum ImGuiTableRowFlags_ +{ + ImGuiTableRowFlags_None = 0, + ImGuiTableRowFlags_Headers = 1 << 0 // Identify header row (set default background color + width of its contents accounted different for auto column width) +}; + +// Enum for ImGui::TableSetBgColor() +// Background colors are rendering in 3 layers: +// - Layer 0: draw with RowBg0 color if set, otherwise draw with ColumnBg0 if set. +// - Layer 1: draw with RowBg1 color if set, otherwise draw with ColumnBg1 if set. +// - Layer 2: draw with CellBg color if set. +// The purpose of the two row/columns layers is to let you decide if a background color changes should override or blend with the existing color. +// When using ImGuiTableFlags_RowBg on the table, each row has the RowBg0 color automatically set for odd/even rows. +// If you set the color of RowBg0 target, your color will override the existing RowBg0 color. +// If you set the color of RowBg1 or ColumnBg1 target, your color will blend over the RowBg0 color. +enum ImGuiTableBgTarget_ +{ + ImGuiTableBgTarget_None = 0, + ImGuiTableBgTarget_RowBg0 = 1, // Set row background color 0 (generally used for background, automatically set when ImGuiTableFlags_RowBg is used) + ImGuiTableBgTarget_RowBg1 = 2, // Set row background color 1 (generally used for selection marking) + ImGuiTableBgTarget_CellBg = 3 // Set cell background color (top-most color) +}; + +// Flags for ImGui::IsWindowFocused() +enum ImGuiFocusedFlags_ +{ + ImGuiFocusedFlags_None = 0, + ImGuiFocusedFlags_ChildWindows = 1 << 0, // IsWindowFocused(): Return true if any children of the window is focused + ImGuiFocusedFlags_RootWindow = 1 << 1, // IsWindowFocused(): Test from root window (top most parent of the current hierarchy) + ImGuiFocusedFlags_AnyWindow = 1 << 2, // IsWindowFocused(): Return true if any window is focused. Important: If you are trying to tell how to dispatch your low-level inputs, do NOT use this. Use 'io.WantCaptureMouse' instead! Please read the FAQ! + ImGuiFocusedFlags_RootAndChildWindows = ImGuiFocusedFlags_RootWindow | ImGuiFocusedFlags_ChildWindows +}; + +// Flags for ImGui::IsItemHovered(), ImGui::IsWindowHovered() +// Note: if you are trying to check whether your mouse should be dispatched to Dear ImGui or to your app, you should use 'io.WantCaptureMouse' instead! Please read the FAQ! +// Note: windows with the ImGuiWindowFlags_NoInputs flag are ignored by IsWindowHovered() calls. +enum ImGuiHoveredFlags_ +{ + ImGuiHoveredFlags_None = 0, // Return true if directly over the item/window, not obstructed by another window, not obstructed by an active popup or modal blocking inputs under them. + ImGuiHoveredFlags_ChildWindows = 1 << 0, // IsWindowHovered() only: Return true if any children of the window is hovered + ImGuiHoveredFlags_RootWindow = 1 << 1, // IsWindowHovered() only: Test from root window (top most parent of the current hierarchy) + ImGuiHoveredFlags_AnyWindow = 1 << 2, // IsWindowHovered() only: Return true if any window is hovered + ImGuiHoveredFlags_AllowWhenBlockedByPopup = 1 << 3, // Return true even if a popup window is normally blocking access to this item/window + //ImGuiHoveredFlags_AllowWhenBlockedByModal = 1 << 4, // Return true even if a modal popup window is normally blocking access to this item/window. FIXME-TODO: Unavailable yet. + ImGuiHoveredFlags_AllowWhenBlockedByActiveItem = 1 << 5, // Return true even if an active item is blocking access to this item/window. Useful for Drag and Drop patterns. + ImGuiHoveredFlags_AllowWhenOverlapped = 1 << 6, // Return true even if the position is obstructed or overlapped by another window + ImGuiHoveredFlags_AllowWhenDisabled = 1 << 7, // Return true even if the item is disabled + ImGuiHoveredFlags_RectOnly = ImGuiHoveredFlags_AllowWhenBlockedByPopup | ImGuiHoveredFlags_AllowWhenBlockedByActiveItem | ImGuiHoveredFlags_AllowWhenOverlapped, + ImGuiHoveredFlags_RootAndChildWindows = ImGuiHoveredFlags_RootWindow | ImGuiHoveredFlags_ChildWindows +}; + +// Flags for ImGui::BeginDragDropSource(), ImGui::AcceptDragDropPayload() +enum ImGuiDragDropFlags_ +{ + ImGuiDragDropFlags_None = 0, + // BeginDragDropSource() flags + ImGuiDragDropFlags_SourceNoPreviewTooltip = 1 << 0, // By default, a successful call to BeginDragDropSource opens a tooltip so you can display a preview or description of the source contents. This flag disable this behavior. + ImGuiDragDropFlags_SourceNoDisableHover = 1 << 1, // By default, when dragging we clear data so that IsItemHovered() will return false, to avoid subsequent user code submitting tooltips. This flag disable this behavior so you can still call IsItemHovered() on the source item. + ImGuiDragDropFlags_SourceNoHoldToOpenOthers = 1 << 2, // Disable the behavior that allows to open tree nodes and collapsing header by holding over them while dragging a source item. + ImGuiDragDropFlags_SourceAllowNullID = 1 << 3, // Allow items such as Text(), Image() that have no unique identifier to be used as drag source, by manufacturing a temporary identifier based on their window-relative position. This is extremely unusual within the dear imgui ecosystem and so we made it explicit. + ImGuiDragDropFlags_SourceExtern = 1 << 4, // External source (from outside of dear imgui), won't attempt to read current item/window info. Will always return true. Only one Extern source can be active simultaneously. + ImGuiDragDropFlags_SourceAutoExpirePayload = 1 << 5, // Automatically expire the payload if the source cease to be submitted (otherwise payloads are persisting while being dragged) + // AcceptDragDropPayload() flags + ImGuiDragDropFlags_AcceptBeforeDelivery = 1 << 10, // AcceptDragDropPayload() will returns true even before the mouse button is released. You can then call IsDelivery() to test if the payload needs to be delivered. + ImGuiDragDropFlags_AcceptNoDrawDefaultRect = 1 << 11, // Do not draw the default highlight rectangle when hovering over target. + ImGuiDragDropFlags_AcceptNoPreviewTooltip = 1 << 12, // Request hiding the BeginDragDropSource tooltip from the BeginDragDropTarget site. + ImGuiDragDropFlags_AcceptPeekOnly = ImGuiDragDropFlags_AcceptBeforeDelivery | ImGuiDragDropFlags_AcceptNoDrawDefaultRect // For peeking ahead and inspecting the payload before delivery. +}; + +// Standard Drag and Drop payload types. You can define you own payload types using short strings. Types starting with '_' are defined by Dear ImGui. +#define IMGUI_PAYLOAD_TYPE_COLOR_3F "_COL3F" // float[3]: Standard type for colors, without alpha. User code may use this type. +#define IMGUI_PAYLOAD_TYPE_COLOR_4F "_COL4F" // float[4]: Standard type for colors. User code may use this type. + +// A primary data type +enum ImGuiDataType_ +{ + ImGuiDataType_S8, // signed char / char (with sensible compilers) + ImGuiDataType_U8, // unsigned char + ImGuiDataType_S16, // short + ImGuiDataType_U16, // unsigned short + ImGuiDataType_S32, // int + ImGuiDataType_U32, // unsigned int + ImGuiDataType_S64, // long long / __int64 + ImGuiDataType_U64, // unsigned long long / unsigned __int64 + ImGuiDataType_Float, // float + ImGuiDataType_Double, // double + ImGuiDataType_COUNT +}; + +// A cardinal direction +enum ImGuiDir_ +{ + ImGuiDir_None = -1, + ImGuiDir_Left = 0, + ImGuiDir_Right = 1, + ImGuiDir_Up = 2, + ImGuiDir_Down = 3, + ImGuiDir_COUNT +}; + +// A sorting direction +enum ImGuiSortDirection_ +{ + ImGuiSortDirection_None = 0, + ImGuiSortDirection_Ascending = 1, // Ascending = 0->9, A->Z etc. + ImGuiSortDirection_Descending = 2 // Descending = 9->0, Z->A etc. +}; + +// User fill ImGuiIO.KeyMap[] array with indices into the ImGuiIO.KeysDown[512] array +enum ImGuiKey_ +{ + ImGuiKey_Tab, + ImGuiKey_LeftArrow, + ImGuiKey_RightArrow, + ImGuiKey_UpArrow, + ImGuiKey_DownArrow, + ImGuiKey_PageUp, + ImGuiKey_PageDown, + ImGuiKey_Home, + ImGuiKey_End, + ImGuiKey_Insert, + ImGuiKey_Delete, + ImGuiKey_Backspace, + ImGuiKey_Space, + ImGuiKey_Enter, + ImGuiKey_Escape, + ImGuiKey_KeyPadEnter, + ImGuiKey_A, // for text edit CTRL+A: select all + ImGuiKey_C, // for text edit CTRL+C: copy + ImGuiKey_V, // for text edit CTRL+V: paste + ImGuiKey_X, // for text edit CTRL+X: cut + ImGuiKey_Y, // for text edit CTRL+Y: redo + ImGuiKey_Z, // for text edit CTRL+Z: undo + ImGuiKey_COUNT +}; + +// To test io.KeyMods (which is a combination of individual fields io.KeyCtrl, io.KeyShift, io.KeyAlt set by user/backend) +enum ImGuiKeyModFlags_ +{ + ImGuiKeyModFlags_None = 0, + ImGuiKeyModFlags_Ctrl = 1 << 0, + ImGuiKeyModFlags_Shift = 1 << 1, + ImGuiKeyModFlags_Alt = 1 << 2, + ImGuiKeyModFlags_Super = 1 << 3 +}; + +// Gamepad/Keyboard navigation +// Keyboard: Set io.ConfigFlags |= ImGuiConfigFlags_NavEnableKeyboard to enable. NewFrame() will automatically fill io.NavInputs[] based on your io.KeysDown[] + io.KeyMap[] arrays. +// Gamepad: Set io.ConfigFlags |= ImGuiConfigFlags_NavEnableGamepad to enable. Backend: set ImGuiBackendFlags_HasGamepad and fill the io.NavInputs[] fields before calling NewFrame(). Note that io.NavInputs[] is cleared by EndFrame(). +// Read instructions in imgui.cpp for more details. Download PNG/PSD at http://dearimgui.org/controls_sheets. +enum ImGuiNavInput_ +{ + // Gamepad Mapping + ImGuiNavInput_Activate, // activate / open / toggle / tweak value // e.g. Cross (PS4), A (Xbox), A (Switch), Space (Keyboard) + ImGuiNavInput_Cancel, // cancel / close / exit // e.g. Circle (PS4), B (Xbox), B (Switch), Escape (Keyboard) + ImGuiNavInput_Input, // text input / on-screen keyboard // e.g. Triang.(PS4), Y (Xbox), X (Switch), Return (Keyboard) + ImGuiNavInput_Menu, // tap: toggle menu / hold: focus, move, resize // e.g. Square (PS4), X (Xbox), Y (Switch), Alt (Keyboard) + ImGuiNavInput_DpadLeft, // move / tweak / resize window (w/ PadMenu) // e.g. D-pad Left/Right/Up/Down (Gamepads), Arrow keys (Keyboard) + ImGuiNavInput_DpadRight, // + ImGuiNavInput_DpadUp, // + ImGuiNavInput_DpadDown, // + ImGuiNavInput_LStickLeft, // scroll / move window (w/ PadMenu) // e.g. Left Analog Stick Left/Right/Up/Down + ImGuiNavInput_LStickRight, // + ImGuiNavInput_LStickUp, // + ImGuiNavInput_LStickDown, // + ImGuiNavInput_FocusPrev, // next window (w/ PadMenu) // e.g. L1 or L2 (PS4), LB or LT (Xbox), L or ZL (Switch) + ImGuiNavInput_FocusNext, // prev window (w/ PadMenu) // e.g. R1 or R2 (PS4), RB or RT (Xbox), R or ZL (Switch) + ImGuiNavInput_TweakSlow, // slower tweaks // e.g. L1 or L2 (PS4), LB or LT (Xbox), L or ZL (Switch) + ImGuiNavInput_TweakFast, // faster tweaks // e.g. R1 or R2 (PS4), RB or RT (Xbox), R or ZL (Switch) + + // [Internal] Don't use directly! This is used internally to differentiate keyboard from gamepad inputs for behaviors that require to differentiate them. + // Keyboard behavior that have no corresponding gamepad mapping (e.g. CTRL+TAB) will be directly reading from io.KeysDown[] instead of io.NavInputs[]. + ImGuiNavInput_KeyLeft_, // move left // = Arrow keys + ImGuiNavInput_KeyRight_, // move right + ImGuiNavInput_KeyUp_, // move up + ImGuiNavInput_KeyDown_, // move down + ImGuiNavInput_COUNT, + ImGuiNavInput_InternalStart_ = ImGuiNavInput_KeyLeft_ +}; + +// Configuration flags stored in io.ConfigFlags. Set by user/application. +enum ImGuiConfigFlags_ +{ + ImGuiConfigFlags_None = 0, + ImGuiConfigFlags_NavEnableKeyboard = 1 << 0, // Master keyboard navigation enable flag. NewFrame() will automatically fill io.NavInputs[] based on io.KeysDown[]. + ImGuiConfigFlags_NavEnableGamepad = 1 << 1, // Master gamepad navigation enable flag. This is mostly to instruct your imgui backend to fill io.NavInputs[]. Backend also needs to set ImGuiBackendFlags_HasGamepad. + ImGuiConfigFlags_NavEnableSetMousePos = 1 << 2, // Instruct navigation to move the mouse cursor. May be useful on TV/console systems where moving a virtual mouse is awkward. Will update io.MousePos and set io.WantSetMousePos=true. If enabled you MUST honor io.WantSetMousePos requests in your backend, otherwise ImGui will react as if the mouse is jumping around back and forth. + ImGuiConfigFlags_NavNoCaptureKeyboard = 1 << 3, // Instruct navigation to not set the io.WantCaptureKeyboard flag when io.NavActive is set. + ImGuiConfigFlags_NoMouse = 1 << 4, // Instruct imgui to clear mouse position/buttons in NewFrame(). This allows ignoring the mouse information set by the backend. + ImGuiConfigFlags_NoMouseCursorChange = 1 << 5, // Instruct backend to not alter mouse cursor shape and visibility. Use if the backend cursor changes are interfering with yours and you don't want to use SetMouseCursor() to change mouse cursor. You may want to honor requests from imgui by reading GetMouseCursor() yourself instead. + + // User storage (to allow your backend/engine to communicate to code that may be shared between multiple projects. Those flags are not used by core Dear ImGui) + ImGuiConfigFlags_IsSRGB = 1 << 20, // Application is SRGB-aware. + ImGuiConfigFlags_IsTouchScreen = 1 << 21 // Application is using a touch screen instead of a mouse. +}; + +// Backend capabilities flags stored in io.BackendFlags. Set by imgui_impl_xxx or custom backend. +enum ImGuiBackendFlags_ +{ + ImGuiBackendFlags_None = 0, + ImGuiBackendFlags_HasGamepad = 1 << 0, // Backend Platform supports gamepad and currently has one connected. + ImGuiBackendFlags_HasMouseCursors = 1 << 1, // Backend Platform supports honoring GetMouseCursor() value to change the OS cursor shape. + ImGuiBackendFlags_HasSetMousePos = 1 << 2, // Backend Platform supports io.WantSetMousePos requests to reposition the OS mouse position (only used if ImGuiConfigFlags_NavEnableSetMousePos is set). + ImGuiBackendFlags_RendererHasVtxOffset = 1 << 3 // Backend Renderer supports ImDrawCmd::VtxOffset. This enables output of large meshes (64K+ vertices) while still using 16-bit indices. +}; + +// Enumeration for PushStyleColor() / PopStyleColor() +enum ImGuiCol_ +{ + ImGuiCol_Text, + ImGuiCol_TextDisabled, + ImGuiCol_WindowBg, // Background of normal windows + ImGuiCol_ChildBg, // Background of child windows + ImGuiCol_PopupBg, // Background of popups, menus, tooltips windows + ImGuiCol_Border, + ImGuiCol_BorderShadow, + ImGuiCol_FrameBg, // Background of checkbox, radio button, plot, slider, text input + ImGuiCol_FrameBgHovered, + ImGuiCol_FrameBgActive, + ImGuiCol_TitleBg, + ImGuiCol_TitleBgActive, + ImGuiCol_TitleBgCollapsed, + ImGuiCol_MenuBarBg, + ImGuiCol_ScrollbarBg, + ImGuiCol_ScrollbarGrab, + ImGuiCol_ScrollbarGrabHovered, + ImGuiCol_ScrollbarGrabActive, + ImGuiCol_CheckMark, + ImGuiCol_SliderGrab, + ImGuiCol_SliderGrabActive, + ImGuiCol_Button, + ImGuiCol_ButtonHovered, + ImGuiCol_ButtonActive, + ImGuiCol_Header, // Header* colors are used for CollapsingHeader, TreeNode, Selectable, MenuItem + ImGuiCol_HeaderHovered, + ImGuiCol_HeaderActive, + ImGuiCol_Separator, + ImGuiCol_SeparatorHovered, + ImGuiCol_SeparatorActive, + ImGuiCol_ResizeGrip, + ImGuiCol_ResizeGripHovered, + ImGuiCol_ResizeGripActive, + ImGuiCol_Tab, + ImGuiCol_TabHovered, + ImGuiCol_TabActive, + ImGuiCol_TabUnfocused, + ImGuiCol_TabUnfocusedActive, + ImGuiCol_PlotLines, + ImGuiCol_PlotLinesHovered, + ImGuiCol_PlotHistogram, + ImGuiCol_PlotHistogramHovered, + ImGuiCol_TableHeaderBg, // Table header background + ImGuiCol_TableBorderStrong, // Table outer and header borders (prefer using Alpha=1.0 here) + ImGuiCol_TableBorderLight, // Table inner borders (prefer using Alpha=1.0 here) + ImGuiCol_TableRowBg, // Table row background (even rows) + ImGuiCol_TableRowBgAlt, // Table row background (odd rows) + ImGuiCol_TextSelectedBg, + ImGuiCol_DragDropTarget, + ImGuiCol_NavHighlight, // Gamepad/keyboard: current highlighted item + ImGuiCol_NavWindowingHighlight, // Highlight window when using CTRL+TAB + ImGuiCol_NavWindowingDimBg, // Darken/colorize entire screen behind the CTRL+TAB window list, when active + ImGuiCol_ModalWindowDimBg, // Darken/colorize entire screen behind a modal window, when one is active + ImGuiCol_COUNT +}; + +// Enumeration for PushStyleVar() / PopStyleVar() to temporarily modify the ImGuiStyle structure. +// - The enum only refers to fields of ImGuiStyle which makes sense to be pushed/popped inside UI code. +// During initialization or between frames, feel free to just poke into ImGuiStyle directly. +// - Tip: Use your programming IDE navigation facilities on the names in the _second column_ below to find the actual members and their description. +// In Visual Studio IDE: CTRL+comma ("Edit.NavigateTo") can follow symbols in comments, whereas CTRL+F12 ("Edit.GoToImplementation") cannot. +// With Visual Assist installed: ALT+G ("VAssistX.GoToImplementation") can also follow symbols in comments. +// - When changing this enum, you need to update the associated internal table GStyleVarInfo[] accordingly. This is where we link enum values to members offset/type. +enum ImGuiStyleVar_ +{ + // Enum name --------------------- // Member in ImGuiStyle structure (see ImGuiStyle for descriptions) + ImGuiStyleVar_Alpha, // float Alpha + ImGuiStyleVar_DisabledAlpha, // float DisabledAlpha + ImGuiStyleVar_WindowPadding, // ImVec2 WindowPadding + ImGuiStyleVar_WindowRounding, // float WindowRounding + ImGuiStyleVar_WindowBorderSize, // float WindowBorderSize + ImGuiStyleVar_WindowMinSize, // ImVec2 WindowMinSize + ImGuiStyleVar_WindowTitleAlign, // ImVec2 WindowTitleAlign + ImGuiStyleVar_ChildRounding, // float ChildRounding + ImGuiStyleVar_ChildBorderSize, // float ChildBorderSize + ImGuiStyleVar_PopupRounding, // float PopupRounding + ImGuiStyleVar_PopupBorderSize, // float PopupBorderSize + ImGuiStyleVar_FramePadding, // ImVec2 FramePadding + ImGuiStyleVar_FrameRounding, // float FrameRounding + ImGuiStyleVar_FrameBorderSize, // float FrameBorderSize + ImGuiStyleVar_ItemSpacing, // ImVec2 ItemSpacing + ImGuiStyleVar_ItemInnerSpacing, // ImVec2 ItemInnerSpacing + ImGuiStyleVar_IndentSpacing, // float IndentSpacing + ImGuiStyleVar_CellPadding, // ImVec2 CellPadding + ImGuiStyleVar_ScrollbarSize, // float ScrollbarSize + ImGuiStyleVar_ScrollbarRounding, // float ScrollbarRounding + ImGuiStyleVar_GrabMinSize, // float GrabMinSize + ImGuiStyleVar_GrabRounding, // float GrabRounding + ImGuiStyleVar_TabRounding, // float TabRounding + ImGuiStyleVar_ButtonTextAlign, // ImVec2 ButtonTextAlign + ImGuiStyleVar_SelectableTextAlign, // ImVec2 SelectableTextAlign + ImGuiStyleVar_COUNT +}; + +// Flags for InvisibleButton() [extended in imgui_internal.h] +enum ImGuiButtonFlags_ +{ + ImGuiButtonFlags_None = 0, + ImGuiButtonFlags_MouseButtonLeft = 1 << 0, // React on left mouse button (default) + ImGuiButtonFlags_MouseButtonRight = 1 << 1, // React on right mouse button + ImGuiButtonFlags_MouseButtonMiddle = 1 << 2, // React on center mouse button + + // [Internal] + ImGuiButtonFlags_MouseButtonMask_ = ImGuiButtonFlags_MouseButtonLeft | ImGuiButtonFlags_MouseButtonRight | ImGuiButtonFlags_MouseButtonMiddle, + ImGuiButtonFlags_MouseButtonDefault_ = ImGuiButtonFlags_MouseButtonLeft +}; + +// Flags for ColorEdit3() / ColorEdit4() / ColorPicker3() / ColorPicker4() / ColorButton() +enum ImGuiColorEditFlags_ +{ + ImGuiColorEditFlags_None = 0, + ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha = 1 << 1, // // ColorEdit, ColorPicker, ColorButton: ignore Alpha component (will only read 3 components from the input pointer). + ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoPicker = 1 << 2, // // ColorEdit: disable picker when clicking on color square. + ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoOptions = 1 << 3, // // ColorEdit: disable toggling options menu when right-clicking on inputs/small preview. + ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoSmallPreview = 1 << 4, // // ColorEdit, ColorPicker: disable color square preview next to the inputs. (e.g. to show only the inputs) + ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoInputs = 1 << 5, // // ColorEdit, ColorPicker: disable inputs sliders/text widgets (e.g. to show only the small preview color square). + ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoTooltip = 1 << 6, // // ColorEdit, ColorPicker, ColorButton: disable tooltip when hovering the preview. + ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoLabel = 1 << 7, // // ColorEdit, ColorPicker: disable display of inline text label (the label is still forwarded to the tooltip and picker). + ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoSidePreview = 1 << 8, // // ColorPicker: disable bigger color preview on right side of the picker, use small color square preview instead. + ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoDragDrop = 1 << 9, // // ColorEdit: disable drag and drop target. ColorButton: disable drag and drop source. + ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoBorder = 1 << 10, // // ColorButton: disable border (which is enforced by default) + + // User Options (right-click on widget to change some of them). + ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaBar = 1 << 16, // // ColorEdit, ColorPicker: show vertical alpha bar/gradient in picker. + ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaPreview = 1 << 17, // // ColorEdit, ColorPicker, ColorButton: display preview as a transparent color over a checkerboard, instead of opaque. + ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaPreviewHalf= 1 << 18, // // ColorEdit, ColorPicker, ColorButton: display half opaque / half checkerboard, instead of opaque. + ImGuiColorEditFlags_HDR = 1 << 19, // // (WIP) ColorEdit: Currently only disable 0.0f..1.0f limits in RGBA edition (note: you probably want to use ImGuiColorEditFlags_Float flag as well). + ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayRGB = 1 << 20, // [Display] // ColorEdit: override _display_ type among RGB/HSV/Hex. ColorPicker: select any combination using one or more of RGB/HSV/Hex. + ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayHSV = 1 << 21, // [Display] // " + ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayHex = 1 << 22, // [Display] // " + ImGuiColorEditFlags_Uint8 = 1 << 23, // [DataType] // ColorEdit, ColorPicker, ColorButton: _display_ values formatted as 0..255. + ImGuiColorEditFlags_Float = 1 << 24, // [DataType] // ColorEdit, ColorPicker, ColorButton: _display_ values formatted as 0.0f..1.0f floats instead of 0..255 integers. No round-trip of value via integers. + ImGuiColorEditFlags_PickerHueBar = 1 << 25, // [Picker] // ColorPicker: bar for Hue, rectangle for Sat/Value. + ImGuiColorEditFlags_PickerHueWheel = 1 << 26, // [Picker] // ColorPicker: wheel for Hue, triangle for Sat/Value. + ImGuiColorEditFlags_InputRGB = 1 << 27, // [Input] // ColorEdit, ColorPicker: input and output data in RGB format. + ImGuiColorEditFlags_InputHSV = 1 << 28, // [Input] // ColorEdit, ColorPicker: input and output data in HSV format. + + // Defaults Options. You can set application defaults using SetColorEditOptions(). The intent is that you probably don't want to + // override them in most of your calls. Let the user choose via the option menu and/or call SetColorEditOptions() once during startup. + ImGuiColorEditFlags_DefaultOptions_ = ImGuiColorEditFlags_Uint8 | ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayRGB | ImGuiColorEditFlags_InputRGB | ImGuiColorEditFlags_PickerHueBar, + + // [Internal] Masks + ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayMask_ = ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayRGB | ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayHSV | ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayHex, + ImGuiColorEditFlags_DataTypeMask_ = ImGuiColorEditFlags_Uint8 | ImGuiColorEditFlags_Float, + ImGuiColorEditFlags_PickerMask_ = ImGuiColorEditFlags_PickerHueWheel | ImGuiColorEditFlags_PickerHueBar, + ImGuiColorEditFlags_InputMask_ = ImGuiColorEditFlags_InputRGB | ImGuiColorEditFlags_InputHSV + + // Obsolete names (will be removed) +#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_OBSOLETE_FUNCTIONS + , ImGuiColorEditFlags_RGB = ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayRGB, ImGuiColorEditFlags_HSV = ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayHSV, ImGuiColorEditFlags_HEX = ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayHex // [renamed in 1.69] +#endif +}; + +// Flags for DragFloat(), DragInt(), SliderFloat(), SliderInt() etc. +// We use the same sets of flags for DragXXX() and SliderXXX() functions as the features are the same and it makes it easier to swap them. +enum ImGuiSliderFlags_ +{ + ImGuiSliderFlags_None = 0, + ImGuiSliderFlags_AlwaysClamp = 1 << 4, // Clamp value to min/max bounds when input manually with CTRL+Click. By default CTRL+Click allows going out of bounds. + ImGuiSliderFlags_Logarithmic = 1 << 5, // Make the widget logarithmic (linear otherwise). Consider using ImGuiSliderFlags_NoRoundToFormat with this if using a format-string with small amount of digits. + ImGuiSliderFlags_NoRoundToFormat = 1 << 6, // Disable rounding underlying value to match precision of the display format string (e.g. %.3f values are rounded to those 3 digits) + ImGuiSliderFlags_NoInput = 1 << 7, // Disable CTRL+Click or Enter key allowing to input text directly into the widget + ImGuiSliderFlags_InvalidMask_ = 0x7000000F // [Internal] We treat using those bits as being potentially a 'float power' argument from the previous API that has got miscast to this enum, and will trigger an assert if needed. + + // Obsolete names (will be removed) +#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_OBSOLETE_FUNCTIONS + , ImGuiSliderFlags_ClampOnInput = ImGuiSliderFlags_AlwaysClamp // [renamed in 1.79] +#endif +}; + +// Identify a mouse button. +// Those values are guaranteed to be stable and we frequently use 0/1 directly. Named enums provided for convenience. +enum ImGuiMouseButton_ +{ + ImGuiMouseButton_Left = 0, + ImGuiMouseButton_Right = 1, + ImGuiMouseButton_Middle = 2, + ImGuiMouseButton_COUNT = 5 +}; + +// Enumeration for GetMouseCursor() +// User code may request backend to display given cursor by calling SetMouseCursor(), which is why we have some cursors that are marked unused here +enum ImGuiMouseCursor_ +{ + ImGuiMouseCursor_None = -1, + ImGuiMouseCursor_Arrow = 0, + ImGuiMouseCursor_TextInput, // When hovering over InputText, etc. + ImGuiMouseCursor_ResizeAll, // (Unused by Dear ImGui functions) + ImGuiMouseCursor_ResizeNS, // When hovering over an horizontal border + ImGuiMouseCursor_ResizeEW, // When hovering over a vertical border or a column + ImGuiMouseCursor_ResizeNESW, // When hovering over the bottom-left corner of a window + ImGuiMouseCursor_ResizeNWSE, // When hovering over the bottom-right corner of a window + ImGuiMouseCursor_Hand, // (Unused by Dear ImGui functions. Use for e.g. hyperlinks) + ImGuiMouseCursor_NotAllowed, // When hovering something with disallowed interaction. Usually a crossed circle. + ImGuiMouseCursor_COUNT +}; + +// Enumeration for ImGui::SetWindow***(), SetNextWindow***(), SetNextItem***() functions +// Represent a condition. +// Important: Treat as a regular enum! Do NOT combine multiple values using binary operators! All the functions above treat 0 as a shortcut to ImGuiCond_Always. +enum ImGuiCond_ +{ + ImGuiCond_None = 0, // No condition (always set the variable), same as _Always + ImGuiCond_Always = 1 << 0, // No condition (always set the variable) + ImGuiCond_Once = 1 << 1, // Set the variable once per runtime session (only the first call will succeed) + ImGuiCond_FirstUseEver = 1 << 2, // Set the variable if the object/window has no persistently saved data (no entry in .ini file) + ImGuiCond_Appearing = 1 << 3 // Set the variable if the object/window is appearing after being hidden/inactive (or the first time) +}; + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Helpers: Memory allocations macros, ImVector<> +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// IM_MALLOC(), IM_FREE(), IM_NEW(), IM_PLACEMENT_NEW(), IM_DELETE() +// We call C++ constructor on own allocated memory via the placement "new(ptr) Type()" syntax. +// Defining a custom placement new() with a custom parameter allows us to bypass including which on some platforms complains when user has disabled exceptions. +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +struct ImNewWrapper {}; +inline void* operator new(size_t, ImNewWrapper, void* ptr) { return ptr; } +inline void operator delete(void*, ImNewWrapper, void*) {} // This is only required so we can use the symmetrical new() +#define IM_ALLOC(_SIZE) ImGui::MemAlloc(_SIZE) +#define IM_FREE(_PTR) ImGui::MemFree(_PTR) +#define IM_PLACEMENT_NEW(_PTR) new(ImNewWrapper(), _PTR) +#define IM_NEW(_TYPE) new(ImNewWrapper(), ImGui::MemAlloc(sizeof(_TYPE))) _TYPE +template void IM_DELETE(T* p) { if (p) { p->~T(); ImGui::MemFree(p); } } + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// ImVector<> +// Lightweight std::vector<>-like class to avoid dragging dependencies (also, some implementations of STL with debug enabled are absurdly slow, we bypass it so our code runs fast in debug). +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// - You generally do NOT need to care or use this ever. But we need to make it available in imgui.h because some of our public structures are relying on it. +// - We use std-like naming convention here, which is a little unusual for this codebase. +// - Important: clear() frees memory, resize(0) keep the allocated buffer. We use resize(0) a lot to intentionally recycle allocated buffers across frames and amortize our costs. +// - Important: our implementation does NOT call C++ constructors/destructors, we treat everything as raw data! This is intentional but be extra mindful of that, +// Do NOT use this class as a std::vector replacement in your own code! Many of the structures used by dear imgui can be safely initialized by a zero-memset. +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +IM_MSVC_RUNTIME_CHECKS_OFF +template +struct ImVector +{ + int Size; + int Capacity; + T* Data; + + // Provide standard typedefs but we don't use them ourselves. + typedef T value_type; + typedef value_type* iterator; + typedef const value_type* const_iterator; + + // Constructors, destructor + inline ImVector() { Size = Capacity = 0; Data = NULL; } + inline ImVector(const ImVector& src) { Size = Capacity = 0; Data = NULL; operator=(src); } + inline ImVector& operator=(const ImVector& src) { clear(); resize(src.Size); memcpy(Data, src.Data, (size_t)Size * sizeof(T)); return *this; } + inline ~ImVector() { if (Data) IM_FREE(Data); } // Important: does not destruct anything + + inline void clear() { if (Data) { Size = Capacity = 0; IM_FREE(Data); Data = NULL; } } // Important: does not destruct anything + inline void clear_delete() { for (int n = 0; n < Size; n++) IM_DELETE(Data[n]); clear(); } // Important: never called automatically! always explicit. + inline void clear_destruct() { for (int n = 0; n < Size; n++) Data[n].~T(); clear(); } // Important: never called automatically! always explicit. + + inline bool empty() const { return Size == 0; } + inline int size() const { return Size; } + inline int size_in_bytes() const { return Size * (int)sizeof(T); } + inline int max_size() const { return 0x7FFFFFFF / (int)sizeof(T); } + inline int capacity() const { return Capacity; } + inline T& operator[](int i) { IM_ASSERT(i >= 0 && i < Size); return Data[i]; } + inline const T& operator[](int i) const { IM_ASSERT(i >= 0 && i < Size); return Data[i]; } + + inline T* begin() { return Data; } + inline const T* begin() const { return Data; } + inline T* end() { return Data + Size; } + inline const T* end() const { return Data + Size; } + inline T& front() { IM_ASSERT(Size > 0); return Data[0]; } + inline const T& front() const { IM_ASSERT(Size > 0); return Data[0]; } + inline T& back() { IM_ASSERT(Size > 0); return Data[Size - 1]; } + inline const T& back() const { IM_ASSERT(Size > 0); return Data[Size - 1]; } + inline void swap(ImVector& rhs) { int rhs_size = rhs.Size; rhs.Size = Size; Size = rhs_size; int rhs_cap = rhs.Capacity; rhs.Capacity = Capacity; Capacity = rhs_cap; T* rhs_data = rhs.Data; rhs.Data = Data; Data = rhs_data; } + + inline int _grow_capacity(int sz) const { int new_capacity = Capacity ? (Capacity + Capacity / 2) : 8; return new_capacity > sz ? new_capacity : sz; } + inline void resize(int new_size) { if (new_size > Capacity) reserve(_grow_capacity(new_size)); Size = new_size; } + inline void resize(int new_size, const T& v) { if (new_size > Capacity) reserve(_grow_capacity(new_size)); if (new_size > Size) for (int n = Size; n < new_size; n++) memcpy(&Data[n], &v, sizeof(v)); Size = new_size; } + inline void shrink(int new_size) { IM_ASSERT(new_size <= Size); Size = new_size; } // Resize a vector to a smaller size, guaranteed not to cause a reallocation + inline void reserve(int new_capacity) { if (new_capacity <= Capacity) return; T* new_data = (T*)IM_ALLOC((size_t)new_capacity * sizeof(T)); if (Data) { memcpy(new_data, Data, (size_t)Size * sizeof(T)); IM_FREE(Data); } Data = new_data; Capacity = new_capacity; } + + // NB: It is illegal to call push_back/push_front/insert with a reference pointing inside the ImVector data itself! e.g. v.push_back(v[10]) is forbidden. + inline void push_back(const T& v) { if (Size == Capacity) reserve(_grow_capacity(Size + 1)); memcpy(&Data[Size], &v, sizeof(v)); Size++; } + inline void pop_back() { IM_ASSERT(Size > 0); Size--; } + inline void push_front(const T& v) { if (Size == 0) push_back(v); else insert(Data, v); } + inline T* erase(const T* it) { IM_ASSERT(it >= Data && it < Data + Size); const ptrdiff_t off = it - Data; memmove(Data + off, Data + off + 1, ((size_t)Size - (size_t)off - 1) * sizeof(T)); Size--; return Data + off; } + inline T* erase(const T* it, const T* it_last){ IM_ASSERT(it >= Data && it < Data + Size && it_last > it && it_last <= Data + Size); const ptrdiff_t count = it_last - it; const ptrdiff_t off = it - Data; memmove(Data + off, Data + off + count, ((size_t)Size - (size_t)off - count) * sizeof(T)); Size -= (int)count; return Data + off; } + inline T* erase_unsorted(const T* it) { IM_ASSERT(it >= Data && it < Data + Size); const ptrdiff_t off = it - Data; if (it < Data + Size - 1) memcpy(Data + off, Data + Size - 1, sizeof(T)); Size--; return Data + off; } + inline T* insert(const T* it, const T& v) { IM_ASSERT(it >= Data && it <= Data + Size); const ptrdiff_t off = it - Data; if (Size == Capacity) reserve(_grow_capacity(Size + 1)); if (off < (int)Size) memmove(Data + off + 1, Data + off, ((size_t)Size - (size_t)off) * sizeof(T)); memcpy(&Data[off], &v, sizeof(v)); Size++; return Data + off; } + inline bool contains(const T& v) const { const T* data = Data; const T* data_end = Data + Size; while (data < data_end) if (*data++ == v) return true; return false; } + inline T* find(const T& v) { T* data = Data; const T* data_end = Data + Size; while (data < data_end) if (*data == v) break; else ++data; return data; } + inline const T* find(const T& v) const { const T* data = Data; const T* data_end = Data + Size; while (data < data_end) if (*data == v) break; else ++data; return data; } + inline bool find_erase(const T& v) { const T* it = find(v); if (it < Data + Size) { erase(it); return true; } return false; } + inline bool find_erase_unsorted(const T& v) { const T* it = find(v); if (it < Data + Size) { erase_unsorted(it); return true; } return false; } + inline int index_from_ptr(const T* it) const { IM_ASSERT(it >= Data && it < Data + Size); const ptrdiff_t off = it - Data; return (int)off; } +}; +IM_MSVC_RUNTIME_CHECKS_RESTORE + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] ImGuiStyle +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// You may modify the ImGui::GetStyle() main instance during initialization and before NewFrame(). +// During the frame, use ImGui::PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_XXXX)/PopStyleVar() to alter the main style values, +// and ImGui::PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_XXX)/PopStyleColor() for colors. +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +struct ImGuiStyle +{ + float Alpha; // Global alpha applies to everything in Dear ImGui. + float DisabledAlpha; // Additional alpha multiplier applied by BeginDisabled(). Multiply over current value of Alpha. + ImVec2 WindowPadding; // Padding within a window. + float WindowRounding; // Radius of window corners rounding. Set to 0.0f to have rectangular windows. Large values tend to lead to variety of artifacts and are not recommended. + float WindowBorderSize; // Thickness of border around windows. Generally set to 0.0f or 1.0f. (Other values are not well tested and more CPU/GPU costly). + ImVec2 WindowMinSize; // Minimum window size. This is a global setting. If you want to constraint individual windows, use SetNextWindowSizeConstraints(). + ImVec2 WindowTitleAlign; // Alignment for title bar text. Defaults to (0.0f,0.5f) for left-aligned,vertically centered. + ImGuiDir WindowMenuButtonPosition; // Side of the collapsing/docking button in the title bar (None/Left/Right). Defaults to ImGuiDir_Left. + float ChildRounding; // Radius of child window corners rounding. Set to 0.0f to have rectangular windows. + float ChildBorderSize; // Thickness of border around child windows. Generally set to 0.0f or 1.0f. (Other values are not well tested and more CPU/GPU costly). + float PopupRounding; // Radius of popup window corners rounding. (Note that tooltip windows use WindowRounding) + float PopupBorderSize; // Thickness of border around popup/tooltip windows. Generally set to 0.0f or 1.0f. (Other values are not well tested and more CPU/GPU costly). + ImVec2 FramePadding; // Padding within a framed rectangle (used by most widgets). + float FrameRounding; // Radius of frame corners rounding. Set to 0.0f to have rectangular frame (used by most widgets). + float FrameBorderSize; // Thickness of border around frames. Generally set to 0.0f or 1.0f. (Other values are not well tested and more CPU/GPU costly). + ImVec2 ItemSpacing; // Horizontal and vertical spacing between widgets/lines. + ImVec2 ItemInnerSpacing; // Horizontal and vertical spacing between within elements of a composed widget (e.g. a slider and its label). + ImVec2 CellPadding; // Padding within a table cell + ImVec2 TouchExtraPadding; // Expand reactive bounding box for touch-based system where touch position is not accurate enough. Unfortunately we don't sort widgets so priority on overlap will always be given to the first widget. So don't grow this too much! + float IndentSpacing; // Horizontal indentation when e.g. entering a tree node. Generally == (FontSize + FramePadding.x*2). + float ColumnsMinSpacing; // Minimum horizontal spacing between two columns. Preferably > (FramePadding.x + 1). + float ScrollbarSize; // Width of the vertical scrollbar, Height of the horizontal scrollbar. + float ScrollbarRounding; // Radius of grab corners for scrollbar. + float GrabMinSize; // Minimum width/height of a grab box for slider/scrollbar. + float GrabRounding; // Radius of grabs corners rounding. Set to 0.0f to have rectangular slider grabs. + float LogSliderDeadzone; // The size in pixels of the dead-zone around zero on logarithmic sliders that cross zero. + float TabRounding; // Radius of upper corners of a tab. Set to 0.0f to have rectangular tabs. + float TabBorderSize; // Thickness of border around tabs. + float TabMinWidthForCloseButton; // Minimum width for close button to appears on an unselected tab when hovered. Set to 0.0f to always show when hovering, set to FLT_MAX to never show close button unless selected. + ImGuiDir ColorButtonPosition; // Side of the color button in the ColorEdit4 widget (left/right). Defaults to ImGuiDir_Right. + ImVec2 ButtonTextAlign; // Alignment of button text when button is larger than text. Defaults to (0.5f, 0.5f) (centered). + ImVec2 SelectableTextAlign; // Alignment of selectable text. Defaults to (0.0f, 0.0f) (top-left aligned). It's generally important to keep this left-aligned if you want to lay multiple items on a same line. + ImVec2 DisplayWindowPadding; // Window position are clamped to be visible within the display area or monitors by at least this amount. Only applies to regular windows. + ImVec2 DisplaySafeAreaPadding; // If you cannot see the edges of your screen (e.g. on a TV) increase the safe area padding. Apply to popups/tooltips as well regular windows. NB: Prefer configuring your TV sets correctly! + float MouseCursorScale; // Scale software rendered mouse cursor (when io.MouseDrawCursor is enabled). May be removed later. + bool AntiAliasedLines; // Enable anti-aliased lines/borders. Disable if you are really tight on CPU/GPU. Latched at the beginning of the frame (copied to ImDrawList). + bool AntiAliasedLinesUseTex; // Enable anti-aliased lines/borders using textures where possible. Require backend to render with bilinear filtering. Latched at the beginning of the frame (copied to ImDrawList). + bool AntiAliasedFill; // Enable anti-aliased edges around filled shapes (rounded rectangles, circles, etc.). Disable if you are really tight on CPU/GPU. Latched at the beginning of the frame (copied to ImDrawList). + float CurveTessellationTol; // Tessellation tolerance when using PathBezierCurveTo() without a specific number of segments. Decrease for highly tessellated curves (higher quality, more polygons), increase to reduce quality. + float CircleTessellationMaxError; // Maximum error (in pixels) allowed when using AddCircle()/AddCircleFilled() or drawing rounded corner rectangles with no explicit segment count specified. Decrease for higher quality but more geometry. + ImVec4 Colors[ImGuiCol_COUNT]; + + IMGUI_API ImGuiStyle(); + IMGUI_API void ScaleAllSizes(float scale_factor); +}; + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] ImGuiIO +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// Communicate most settings and inputs/outputs to Dear ImGui using this structure. +// Access via ImGui::GetIO(). Read 'Programmer guide' section in .cpp file for general usage. +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +struct ImGuiIO +{ + //------------------------------------------------------------------ + // Configuration (fill once) // Default value + //------------------------------------------------------------------ + + ImGuiConfigFlags ConfigFlags; // = 0 // See ImGuiConfigFlags_ enum. Set by user/application. Gamepad/keyboard navigation options, etc. + ImGuiBackendFlags BackendFlags; // = 0 // See ImGuiBackendFlags_ enum. Set by backend (imgui_impl_xxx files or custom backend) to communicate features supported by the backend. + ImVec2 DisplaySize; // // Main display size, in pixels (generally == GetMainViewport()->Size) + float DeltaTime; // = 1.0f/60.0f // Time elapsed since last frame, in seconds. + float IniSavingRate; // = 5.0f // Minimum time between saving positions/sizes to .ini file, in seconds. + const char* IniFilename; // = "imgui.ini" // Path to .ini file (important: default "imgui.ini" is relative to current working dir!). Set NULL to disable automatic .ini loading/saving or if you want to manually call LoadIniSettingsXXX() / SaveIniSettingsXXX() functions. + const char* LogFilename; // = "imgui_log.txt"// Path to .log file (default parameter to ImGui::LogToFile when no file is specified). + float MouseDoubleClickTime; // = 0.30f // Time for a double-click, in seconds. + float MouseDoubleClickMaxDist; // = 6.0f // Distance threshold to stay in to validate a double-click, in pixels. + float MouseDragThreshold; // = 6.0f // Distance threshold before considering we are dragging. + int KeyMap[ImGuiKey_COUNT]; // // Map of indices into the KeysDown[512] entries array which represent your "native" keyboard state. + float KeyRepeatDelay; // = 0.250f // When holding a key/button, time before it starts repeating, in seconds (for buttons in Repeat mode, etc.). + float KeyRepeatRate; // = 0.050f // When holding a key/button, rate at which it repeats, in seconds. + void* UserData; // = NULL // Store your own data for retrieval by callbacks. + + ImFontAtlas*Fonts; // // Font atlas: load, rasterize and pack one or more fonts into a single texture. + float FontGlobalScale; // = 1.0f // Global scale all fonts + bool FontAllowUserScaling; // = false // Allow user scaling text of individual window with CTRL+Wheel. + ImFont* FontDefault; // = NULL // Font to use on NewFrame(). Use NULL to uses Fonts->Fonts[0]. + ImVec2 DisplayFramebufferScale; // = (1, 1) // For retina display or other situations where window coordinates are different from framebuffer coordinates. This generally ends up in ImDrawData::FramebufferScale. + + // Miscellaneous options + bool MouseDrawCursor; // = false // Request ImGui to draw a mouse cursor for you (if you are on a platform without a mouse cursor). Cannot be easily renamed to 'io.ConfigXXX' because this is frequently used by backend implementations. + bool ConfigMacOSXBehaviors; // = defined(__APPLE__) // OS X style: Text editing cursor movement using Alt instead of Ctrl, Shortcuts using Cmd/Super instead of Ctrl, Line/Text Start and End using Cmd+Arrows instead of Home/End, Double click selects by word instead of selecting whole text, Multi-selection in lists uses Cmd/Super instead of Ctrl. + bool ConfigInputTextCursorBlink; // = true // Enable blinking cursor (optional as some users consider it to be distracting). + bool ConfigDragClickToInputText; // = false // [BETA] Enable turning DragXXX widgets into text input with a simple mouse click-release (without moving). Not desirable on devices without a keyboard. + bool ConfigWindowsResizeFromEdges; // = true // Enable resizing of windows from their edges and from the lower-left corner. This requires (io.BackendFlags & ImGuiBackendFlags_HasMouseCursors) because it needs mouse cursor feedback. (This used to be a per-window ImGuiWindowFlags_ResizeFromAnySide flag) + bool ConfigWindowsMoveFromTitleBarOnly; // = false // Enable allowing to move windows only when clicking on their title bar. Does not apply to windows without a title bar. + float ConfigMemoryCompactTimer; // = 60.0f // Timer (in seconds) to free transient windows/tables memory buffers when unused. Set to -1.0f to disable. + + //------------------------------------------------------------------ + // Platform Functions + // (the imgui_impl_xxxx backend files are setting those up for you) + //------------------------------------------------------------------ + + // Optional: Platform/Renderer backend name (informational only! will be displayed in About Window) + User data for backend/wrappers to store their own stuff. + const char* BackendPlatformName; // = NULL + const char* BackendRendererName; // = NULL + void* BackendPlatformUserData; // = NULL // User data for platform backend + void* BackendRendererUserData; // = NULL // User data for renderer backend + void* BackendLanguageUserData; // = NULL // User data for non C++ programming language backend + + // Optional: Access OS clipboard + // (default to use native Win32 clipboard on Windows, otherwise uses a private clipboard. Override to access OS clipboard on other architectures) + const char* (*GetClipboardTextFn)(void* user_data); + void (*SetClipboardTextFn)(void* user_data, const char* text); + void* ClipboardUserData; + + // Optional: Notify OS Input Method Editor of the screen position of your cursor for text input position (e.g. when using Japanese/Chinese IME on Windows) + // (default to use native imm32 api on Windows) + void (*ImeSetInputScreenPosFn)(int x, int y); + void* ImeWindowHandle; // = NULL // (Windows) Set this to your HWND to get automatic IME cursor positioning. + + //------------------------------------------------------------------ + // Input - Fill before calling NewFrame() + //------------------------------------------------------------------ + + ImVec2 MousePos; // Mouse position, in pixels. Set to ImVec2(-FLT_MAX, -FLT_MAX) if mouse is unavailable (on another screen, etc.) + bool MouseDown[5]; // Mouse buttons: 0=left, 1=right, 2=middle + extras (ImGuiMouseButton_COUNT == 5). Dear ImGui mostly uses left and right buttons. Others buttons allows us to track if the mouse is being used by your application + available to user as a convenience via IsMouse** API. + float MouseWheel; // Mouse wheel Vertical: 1 unit scrolls about 5 lines text. + float MouseWheelH; // Mouse wheel Horizontal. Most users don't have a mouse with an horizontal wheel, may not be filled by all backends. + bool KeyCtrl; // Keyboard modifier pressed: Control + bool KeyShift; // Keyboard modifier pressed: Shift + bool KeyAlt; // Keyboard modifier pressed: Alt + bool KeySuper; // Keyboard modifier pressed: Cmd/Super/Windows + bool KeysDown[512]; // Keyboard keys that are pressed (ideally left in the "native" order your engine has access to keyboard keys, so you can use your own defines/enums for keys). + float NavInputs[ImGuiNavInput_COUNT]; // Gamepad inputs. Cleared back to zero by EndFrame(). Keyboard keys will be auto-mapped and be written here by NewFrame(). + + // Functions + IMGUI_API void AddInputCharacter(unsigned int c); // Queue new character input + IMGUI_API void AddInputCharacterUTF16(ImWchar16 c); // Queue new character input from an UTF-16 character, it can be a surrogate + IMGUI_API void AddInputCharactersUTF8(const char* str); // Queue new characters input from an UTF-8 string + IMGUI_API void ClearInputCharacters(); // Clear the text input buffer manually + IMGUI_API void AddFocusEvent(bool focused); // Notifies Dear ImGui when hosting platform windows lose or gain input focus + + //------------------------------------------------------------------ + // Output - Updated by NewFrame() or EndFrame()/Render() + // (when reading from the io.WantCaptureMouse, io.WantCaptureKeyboard flags to dispatch your inputs, it is + // generally easier and more correct to use their state BEFORE calling NewFrame(). See FAQ for details!) + //------------------------------------------------------------------ + + bool WantCaptureMouse; // Set when Dear ImGui will use mouse inputs, in this case do not dispatch them to your main game/application (either way, always pass on mouse inputs to imgui). (e.g. unclicked mouse is hovering over an imgui window, widget is active, mouse was clicked over an imgui window, etc.). + bool WantCaptureKeyboard; // Set when Dear ImGui will use keyboard inputs, in this case do not dispatch them to your main game/application (either way, always pass keyboard inputs to imgui). (e.g. InputText active, or an imgui window is focused and navigation is enabled, etc.). + bool WantTextInput; // Mobile/console: when set, you may display an on-screen keyboard. This is set by Dear ImGui when it wants textual keyboard input to happen (e.g. when a InputText widget is active). + bool WantSetMousePos; // MousePos has been altered, backend should reposition mouse on next frame. Rarely used! Set only when ImGuiConfigFlags_NavEnableSetMousePos flag is enabled. + bool WantSaveIniSettings; // When manual .ini load/save is active (io.IniFilename == NULL), this will be set to notify your application that you can call SaveIniSettingsToMemory() and save yourself. Important: clear io.WantSaveIniSettings yourself after saving! + bool NavActive; // Keyboard/Gamepad navigation is currently allowed (will handle ImGuiKey_NavXXX events) = a window is focused and it doesn't use the ImGuiWindowFlags_NoNavInputs flag. + bool NavVisible; // Keyboard/Gamepad navigation is visible and allowed (will handle ImGuiKey_NavXXX events). + float Framerate; // Rough estimate of application framerate, in frame per second. Solely for convenience. Rolling average estimation based on io.DeltaTime over 120 frames. + int MetricsRenderVertices; // Vertices output during last call to Render() + int MetricsRenderIndices; // Indices output during last call to Render() = number of triangles * 3 + int MetricsRenderWindows; // Number of visible windows + int MetricsActiveWindows; // Number of active windows + int MetricsActiveAllocations; // Number of active allocations, updated by MemAlloc/MemFree based on current context. May be off if you have multiple imgui contexts. + ImVec2 MouseDelta; // Mouse delta. Note that this is zero if either current or previous position are invalid (-FLT_MAX,-FLT_MAX), so a disappearing/reappearing mouse won't have a huge delta. + + //------------------------------------------------------------------ + // [Internal] Dear ImGui will maintain those fields. Forward compatibility not guaranteed! + //------------------------------------------------------------------ + + ImGuiKeyModFlags KeyMods; // Key mods flags (same as io.KeyCtrl/KeyShift/KeyAlt/KeySuper but merged into flags), updated by NewFrame() + ImGuiKeyModFlags KeyModsPrev; // Previous key mods + ImVec2 MousePosPrev; // Previous mouse position (note that MouseDelta is not necessary == MousePos-MousePosPrev, in case either position is invalid) + ImVec2 MouseClickedPos[5]; // Position at time of clicking + double MouseClickedTime[5]; // Time of last click (used to figure out double-click) + bool MouseClicked[5]; // Mouse button went from !Down to Down + bool MouseDoubleClicked[5]; // Has mouse button been double-clicked? + bool MouseReleased[5]; // Mouse button went from Down to !Down + bool MouseDownOwned[5]; // Track if button was clicked inside a dear imgui window. We don't request mouse capture from the application if click started outside ImGui bounds. + bool MouseDownWasDoubleClick[5]; // Track if button down was a double-click + float MouseDownDuration[5]; // Duration the mouse button has been down (0.0f == just clicked) + float MouseDownDurationPrev[5]; // Previous time the mouse button has been down + ImVec2 MouseDragMaxDistanceAbs[5]; // Maximum distance, absolute, on each axis, of how much mouse has traveled from the clicking point + float MouseDragMaxDistanceSqr[5]; // Squared maximum distance of how much mouse has traveled from the clicking point + float KeysDownDuration[512]; // Duration the keyboard key has been down (0.0f == just pressed) + float KeysDownDurationPrev[512]; // Previous duration the key has been down + float NavInputsDownDuration[ImGuiNavInput_COUNT]; + float NavInputsDownDurationPrev[ImGuiNavInput_COUNT]; + float PenPressure; // Touch/Pen pressure (0.0f to 1.0f, should be >0.0f only when MouseDown[0] == true). Helper storage currently unused by Dear ImGui. + ImWchar16 InputQueueSurrogate; // For AddInputCharacterUTF16 + ImVector InputQueueCharacters; // Queue of _characters_ input (obtained by platform backend). Fill using AddInputCharacter() helper. + + IMGUI_API ImGuiIO(); +}; + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Misc data structures +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// Shared state of InputText(), passed as an argument to your callback when a ImGuiInputTextFlags_Callback* flag is used. +// The callback function should return 0 by default. +// Callbacks (follow a flag name and see comments in ImGuiInputTextFlags_ declarations for more details) +// - ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackEdit: Callback on buffer edit (note that InputText() already returns true on edit, the callback is useful mainly to manipulate the underlying buffer while focus is active) +// - ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackAlways: Callback on each iteration +// - ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackCompletion: Callback on pressing TAB +// - ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackHistory: Callback on pressing Up/Down arrows +// - ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackCharFilter: Callback on character inputs to replace or discard them. Modify 'EventChar' to replace or discard, or return 1 in callback to discard. +// - ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackResize: Callback on buffer capacity changes request (beyond 'buf_size' parameter value), allowing the string to grow. +struct ImGuiInputTextCallbackData +{ + ImGuiInputTextFlags EventFlag; // One ImGuiInputTextFlags_Callback* // Read-only + ImGuiInputTextFlags Flags; // What user passed to InputText() // Read-only + void* UserData; // What user passed to InputText() // Read-only + + // Arguments for the different callback events + // - To modify the text buffer in a callback, prefer using the InsertChars() / DeleteChars() function. InsertChars() will take care of calling the resize callback if necessary. + // - If you know your edits are not going to resize the underlying buffer allocation, you may modify the contents of 'Buf[]' directly. You need to update 'BufTextLen' accordingly (0 <= BufTextLen < BufSize) and set 'BufDirty'' to true so InputText can update its internal state. + ImWchar EventChar; // Character input // Read-write // [CharFilter] Replace character with another one, or set to zero to drop. return 1 is equivalent to setting EventChar=0; + ImGuiKey EventKey; // Key pressed (Up/Down/TAB) // Read-only // [Completion,History] + char* Buf; // Text buffer // Read-write // [Resize] Can replace pointer / [Completion,History,Always] Only write to pointed data, don't replace the actual pointer! + int BufTextLen; // Text length (in bytes) // Read-write // [Resize,Completion,History,Always] Exclude zero-terminator storage. In C land: == strlen(some_text), in C++ land: string.length() + int BufSize; // Buffer size (in bytes) = capacity+1 // Read-only // [Resize,Completion,History,Always] Include zero-terminator storage. In C land == ARRAYSIZE(my_char_array), in C++ land: string.capacity()+1 + bool BufDirty; // Set if you modify Buf/BufTextLen! // Write // [Completion,History,Always] + int CursorPos; // // Read-write // [Completion,History,Always] + int SelectionStart; // // Read-write // [Completion,History,Always] == to SelectionEnd when no selection) + int SelectionEnd; // // Read-write // [Completion,History,Always] + + // Helper functions for text manipulation. + // Use those function to benefit from the CallbackResize behaviors. Calling those function reset the selection. + IMGUI_API ImGuiInputTextCallbackData(); + IMGUI_API void DeleteChars(int pos, int bytes_count); + IMGUI_API void InsertChars(int pos, const char* text, const char* text_end = NULL); + void SelectAll() { SelectionStart = 0; SelectionEnd = BufTextLen; } + void ClearSelection() { SelectionStart = SelectionEnd = BufTextLen; } + bool HasSelection() const { return SelectionStart != SelectionEnd; } +}; + +// Resizing callback data to apply custom constraint. As enabled by SetNextWindowSizeConstraints(). Callback is called during the next Begin(). +// NB: For basic min/max size constraint on each axis you don't need to use the callback! The SetNextWindowSizeConstraints() parameters are enough. +struct ImGuiSizeCallbackData +{ + void* UserData; // Read-only. What user passed to SetNextWindowSizeConstraints() + ImVec2 Pos; // Read-only. Window position, for reference. + ImVec2 CurrentSize; // Read-only. Current window size. + ImVec2 DesiredSize; // Read-write. Desired size, based on user's mouse position. Write to this field to restrain resizing. +}; + +// Data payload for Drag and Drop operations: AcceptDragDropPayload(), GetDragDropPayload() +struct ImGuiPayload +{ + // Members + void* Data; // Data (copied and owned by dear imgui) + int DataSize; // Data size + + // [Internal] + ImGuiID SourceId; // Source item id + ImGuiID SourceParentId; // Source parent id (if available) + int DataFrameCount; // Data timestamp + char DataType[32 + 1]; // Data type tag (short user-supplied string, 32 characters max) + bool Preview; // Set when AcceptDragDropPayload() was called and mouse has been hovering the target item (nb: handle overlapping drag targets) + bool Delivery; // Set when AcceptDragDropPayload() was called and mouse button is released over the target item. + + ImGuiPayload() { Clear(); } + void Clear() { SourceId = SourceParentId = 0; Data = NULL; DataSize = 0; memset(DataType, 0, sizeof(DataType)); DataFrameCount = -1; Preview = Delivery = false; } + bool IsDataType(const char* type) const { return DataFrameCount != -1 && strcmp(type, DataType) == 0; } + bool IsPreview() const { return Preview; } + bool IsDelivery() const { return Delivery; } +}; + +// Sorting specification for one column of a table (sizeof == 12 bytes) +struct ImGuiTableColumnSortSpecs +{ + ImGuiID ColumnUserID; // User id of the column (if specified by a TableSetupColumn() call) + ImS16 ColumnIndex; // Index of the column + ImS16 SortOrder; // Index within parent ImGuiTableSortSpecs (always stored in order starting from 0, tables sorted on a single criteria will always have a 0 here) + ImGuiSortDirection SortDirection : 8; // ImGuiSortDirection_Ascending or ImGuiSortDirection_Descending (you can use this or SortSign, whichever is more convenient for your sort function) + + ImGuiTableColumnSortSpecs() { memset(this, 0, sizeof(*this)); } +}; + +// Sorting specifications for a table (often handling sort specs for a single column, occasionally more) +// Obtained by calling TableGetSortSpecs(). +// When 'SpecsDirty == true' you can sort your data. It will be true with sorting specs have changed since last call, or the first time. +// Make sure to set 'SpecsDirty = false' after sorting, else you may wastefully sort your data every frame! +struct ImGuiTableSortSpecs +{ + const ImGuiTableColumnSortSpecs* Specs; // Pointer to sort spec array. + int SpecsCount; // Sort spec count. Most often 1. May be > 1 when ImGuiTableFlags_SortMulti is enabled. May be == 0 when ImGuiTableFlags_SortTristate is enabled. + bool SpecsDirty; // Set to true when specs have changed since last time! Use this to sort again, then clear the flag. + + ImGuiTableSortSpecs() { memset(this, 0, sizeof(*this)); } +}; + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Helpers (ImGuiOnceUponAFrame, ImGuiTextFilter, ImGuiTextBuffer, ImGuiStorage, ImGuiListClipper, ImColor) +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// Helper: Unicode defines +#define IM_UNICODE_CODEPOINT_INVALID 0xFFFD // Invalid Unicode code point (standard value). +#ifdef IMGUI_USE_WCHAR32 +#define IM_UNICODE_CODEPOINT_MAX 0x10FFFF // Maximum Unicode code point supported by this build. +#else +#define IM_UNICODE_CODEPOINT_MAX 0xFFFF // Maximum Unicode code point supported by this build. +#endif + +// Helper: Execute a block of code at maximum once a frame. Convenient if you want to quickly create an UI within deep-nested code that runs multiple times every frame. +// Usage: static ImGuiOnceUponAFrame oaf; if (oaf) ImGui::Text("This will be called only once per frame"); +struct ImGuiOnceUponAFrame +{ + ImGuiOnceUponAFrame() { RefFrame = -1; } + mutable int RefFrame; + operator bool() const { int current_frame = ImGui::GetFrameCount(); if (RefFrame == current_frame) return false; RefFrame = current_frame; return true; } +}; + +// Helper: Parse and apply text filters. In format "aaaaa[,bbbb][,ccccc]" +struct ImGuiTextFilter +{ + IMGUI_API ImGuiTextFilter(const char* default_filter = ""); + IMGUI_API bool Draw(const char* label = "Filter (inc,-exc)", float width = 0.0f); // Helper calling InputText+Build + IMGUI_API bool PassFilter(const char* text, const char* text_end = NULL) const; + IMGUI_API void Build(); + void Clear() { InputBuf[0] = 0; Build(); } + bool IsActive() const { return !Filters.empty(); } + + // [Internal] + struct ImGuiTextRange + { + const char* b; + const char* e; + + ImGuiTextRange() { b = e = NULL; } + ImGuiTextRange(const char* _b, const char* _e) { b = _b; e = _e; } + bool empty() const { return b == e; } + IMGUI_API void split(char separator, ImVector* out) const; + }; + char InputBuf[256]; + ImVectorFilters; + int CountGrep; +}; + +// Helper: Growable text buffer for logging/accumulating text +// (this could be called 'ImGuiTextBuilder' / 'ImGuiStringBuilder') +struct ImGuiTextBuffer +{ + ImVector Buf; + IMGUI_API static char EmptyString[1]; + + ImGuiTextBuffer() { } + inline char operator[](int i) const { IM_ASSERT(Buf.Data != NULL); return Buf.Data[i]; } + const char* begin() const { return Buf.Data ? &Buf.front() : EmptyString; } + const char* end() const { return Buf.Data ? &Buf.back() : EmptyString; } // Buf is zero-terminated, so end() will point on the zero-terminator + int size() const { return Buf.Size ? Buf.Size - 1 : 0; } + bool empty() const { return Buf.Size <= 1; } + void clear() { Buf.clear(); } + void reserve(int capacity) { Buf.reserve(capacity); } + const char* c_str() const { return Buf.Data ? Buf.Data : EmptyString; } + IMGUI_API void append(const char* str, const char* str_end = NULL); + IMGUI_API void appendf(const char* fmt, ...) IM_FMTARGS(2); + IMGUI_API void appendfv(const char* fmt, va_list args) IM_FMTLIST(2); +}; + +// Helper: Key->Value storage +// Typically you don't have to worry about this since a storage is held within each Window. +// We use it to e.g. store collapse state for a tree (Int 0/1) +// This is optimized for efficient lookup (dichotomy into a contiguous buffer) and rare insertion (typically tied to user interactions aka max once a frame) +// You can use it as custom user storage for temporary values. Declare your own storage if, for example: +// - You want to manipulate the open/close state of a particular sub-tree in your interface (tree node uses Int 0/1 to store their state). +// - You want to store custom debug data easily without adding or editing structures in your code (probably not efficient, but convenient) +// Types are NOT stored, so it is up to you to make sure your Key don't collide with different types. +struct ImGuiStorage +{ + // [Internal] + struct ImGuiStoragePair + { + ImGuiID key; + union { int val_i; float val_f; void* val_p; }; + ImGuiStoragePair(ImGuiID _key, int _val_i) { key = _key; val_i = _val_i; } + ImGuiStoragePair(ImGuiID _key, float _val_f) { key = _key; val_f = _val_f; } + ImGuiStoragePair(ImGuiID _key, void* _val_p) { key = _key; val_p = _val_p; } + }; + + ImVector Data; + + // - Get***() functions find pair, never add/allocate. Pairs are sorted so a query is O(log N) + // - Set***() functions find pair, insertion on demand if missing. + // - Sorted insertion is costly, paid once. A typical frame shouldn't need to insert any new pair. + void Clear() { Data.clear(); } + IMGUI_API int GetInt(ImGuiID key, int default_val = 0) const; + IMGUI_API void SetInt(ImGuiID key, int val); + IMGUI_API bool GetBool(ImGuiID key, bool default_val = false) const; + IMGUI_API void SetBool(ImGuiID key, bool val); + IMGUI_API float GetFloat(ImGuiID key, float default_val = 0.0f) const; + IMGUI_API void SetFloat(ImGuiID key, float val); + IMGUI_API void* GetVoidPtr(ImGuiID key) const; // default_val is NULL + IMGUI_API void SetVoidPtr(ImGuiID key, void* val); + + // - Get***Ref() functions finds pair, insert on demand if missing, return pointer. Useful if you intend to do Get+Set. + // - References are only valid until a new value is added to the storage. Calling a Set***() function or a Get***Ref() function invalidates the pointer. + // - A typical use case where this is convenient for quick hacking (e.g. add storage during a live Edit&Continue session if you can't modify existing struct) + // float* pvar = ImGui::GetFloatRef(key); ImGui::SliderFloat("var", pvar, 0, 100.0f); some_var += *pvar; + IMGUI_API int* GetIntRef(ImGuiID key, int default_val = 0); + IMGUI_API bool* GetBoolRef(ImGuiID key, bool default_val = false); + IMGUI_API float* GetFloatRef(ImGuiID key, float default_val = 0.0f); + IMGUI_API void** GetVoidPtrRef(ImGuiID key, void* default_val = NULL); + + // Use on your own storage if you know only integer are being stored (open/close all tree nodes) + IMGUI_API void SetAllInt(int val); + + // For quicker full rebuild of a storage (instead of an incremental one), you may add all your contents and then sort once. + IMGUI_API void BuildSortByKey(); +}; + +// Helper: Manually clip large list of items. +// If you are submitting lots of evenly spaced items and you have a random access to the list, you can perform coarse +// clipping based on visibility to save yourself from processing those items at all. +// The clipper calculates the range of visible items and advance the cursor to compensate for the non-visible items we have skipped. +// (Dear ImGui already clip items based on their bounds but it needs to measure text size to do so, whereas manual coarse clipping before submission makes this cost and your own data fetching/submission cost almost null) +// Usage: +// ImGuiListClipper clipper; +// clipper.Begin(1000); // We have 1000 elements, evenly spaced. +// while (clipper.Step()) +// for (int i = clipper.DisplayStart; i < clipper.DisplayEnd; i++) +// ImGui::Text("line number %d", i); +// Generally what happens is: +// - Clipper lets you process the first element (DisplayStart = 0, DisplayEnd = 1) regardless of it being visible or not. +// - User code submit one element. +// - Clipper can measure the height of the first element +// - Clipper calculate the actual range of elements to display based on the current clipping rectangle, position the cursor before the first visible element. +// - User code submit visible elements. +struct ImGuiListClipper +{ + int DisplayStart; + int DisplayEnd; + + // [Internal] + int ItemsCount; + int StepNo; + int ItemsFrozen; + float ItemsHeight; + float StartPosY; + + IMGUI_API ImGuiListClipper(); + IMGUI_API ~ImGuiListClipper(); + + // items_count: Use INT_MAX if you don't know how many items you have (in which case the cursor won't be advanced in the final step) + // items_height: Use -1.0f to be calculated automatically on first step. Otherwise pass in the distance between your items, typically GetTextLineHeightWithSpacing() or GetFrameHeightWithSpacing(). + IMGUI_API void Begin(int items_count, float items_height = -1.0f); // Automatically called by constructor if you passed 'items_count' or by Step() in Step 1. + IMGUI_API void End(); // Automatically called on the last call of Step() that returns false. + IMGUI_API bool Step(); // Call until it returns false. The DisplayStart/DisplayEnd fields will be set and you can process/draw those items. + +#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_OBSOLETE_FUNCTIONS + inline ImGuiListClipper(int items_count, float items_height = -1.0f) { memset(this, 0, sizeof(*this)); ItemsCount = -1; Begin(items_count, items_height); } // [removed in 1.79] +#endif +}; + +// Helpers macros to generate 32-bit encoded colors +#ifdef IMGUI_USE_BGRA_PACKED_COLOR +#define IM_COL32_R_SHIFT 16 +#define IM_COL32_G_SHIFT 8 +#define IM_COL32_B_SHIFT 0 +#define IM_COL32_A_SHIFT 24 +#define IM_COL32_A_MASK 0xFF000000 +#else +#define IM_COL32_R_SHIFT 0 +#define IM_COL32_G_SHIFT 8 +#define IM_COL32_B_SHIFT 16 +#define IM_COL32_A_SHIFT 24 +#define IM_COL32_A_MASK 0xFF000000 +#endif +#define IM_COL32(R,G,B,A) (((ImU32)(A)<> IM_COL32_R_SHIFT) & 0xFF) * sc; Value.y = (float)((rgba >> IM_COL32_G_SHIFT) & 0xFF) * sc; Value.z = (float)((rgba >> IM_COL32_B_SHIFT) & 0xFF) * sc; Value.w = (float)((rgba >> IM_COL32_A_SHIFT) & 0xFF) * sc; } + ImColor(float r, float g, float b, float a = 1.0f) { Value.x = r; Value.y = g; Value.z = b; Value.w = a; } + ImColor(const ImVec4& col) { Value = col; } + inline operator ImU32() const { return ImGui::ColorConvertFloat4ToU32(Value); } + inline operator ImVec4() const { return Value; } + + // FIXME-OBSOLETE: May need to obsolete/cleanup those helpers. + inline void SetHSV(float h, float s, float v, float a = 1.0f){ ImGui::ColorConvertHSVtoRGB(h, s, v, Value.x, Value.y, Value.z); Value.w = a; } + static ImColor HSV(float h, float s, float v, float a = 1.0f) { float r, g, b; ImGui::ColorConvertHSVtoRGB(h, s, v, r, g, b); return ImColor(r, g, b, a); } +}; + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Drawing API (ImDrawCmd, ImDrawIdx, ImDrawVert, ImDrawChannel, ImDrawListSplitter, ImDrawListFlags, ImDrawList, ImDrawData) +// Hold a series of drawing commands. The user provides a renderer for ImDrawData which essentially contains an array of ImDrawList. +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// The maximum line width to bake anti-aliased textures for. Build atlas with ImFontAtlasFlags_NoBakedLines to disable baking. +#ifndef IM_DRAWLIST_TEX_LINES_WIDTH_MAX +#define IM_DRAWLIST_TEX_LINES_WIDTH_MAX (63) +#endif + +// ImDrawCallback: Draw callbacks for advanced uses [configurable type: override in imconfig.h] +// NB: You most likely do NOT need to use draw callbacks just to create your own widget or customized UI rendering, +// you can poke into the draw list for that! Draw callback may be useful for example to: +// A) Change your GPU render state, +// B) render a complex 3D scene inside a UI element without an intermediate texture/render target, etc. +// The expected behavior from your rendering function is 'if (cmd.UserCallback != NULL) { cmd.UserCallback(parent_list, cmd); } else { RenderTriangles() }' +// If you want to override the signature of ImDrawCallback, you can simply use e.g. '#define ImDrawCallback MyDrawCallback' (in imconfig.h) + update rendering backend accordingly. +#ifndef ImDrawCallback +typedef void (*ImDrawCallback)(const ImDrawList* parent_list, const ImDrawCmd* cmd); +#endif + +// Special Draw callback value to request renderer backend to reset the graphics/render state. +// The renderer backend needs to handle this special value, otherwise it will crash trying to call a function at this address. +// This is useful for example if you submitted callbacks which you know have altered the render state and you want it to be restored. +// It is not done by default because they are many perfectly useful way of altering render state for imgui contents (e.g. changing shader/blending settings before an Image call). +#define ImDrawCallback_ResetRenderState (ImDrawCallback)(-1) + +// Typically, 1 command = 1 GPU draw call (unless command is a callback) +// - VtxOffset/IdxOffset: When 'io.BackendFlags & ImGuiBackendFlags_RendererHasVtxOffset' is enabled, +// those fields allow us to render meshes larger than 64K vertices while keeping 16-bit indices. +// Pre-1.71 backends will typically ignore the VtxOffset/IdxOffset fields. +// - The ClipRect/TextureId/VtxOffset fields must be contiguous as we memcmp() them together (this is asserted for). +struct ImDrawCmd +{ + ImVec4 ClipRect; // 4*4 // Clipping rectangle (x1, y1, x2, y2). Subtract ImDrawData->DisplayPos to get clipping rectangle in "viewport" coordinates + ImTextureID TextureId; // 4-8 // User-provided texture ID. Set by user in ImfontAtlas::SetTexID() for fonts or passed to Image*() functions. Ignore if never using images or multiple fonts atlas. + unsigned int VtxOffset; // 4 // Start offset in vertex buffer. ImGuiBackendFlags_RendererHasVtxOffset: always 0, otherwise may be >0 to support meshes larger than 64K vertices with 16-bit indices. + unsigned int IdxOffset; // 4 // Start offset in index buffer. Always equal to sum of ElemCount drawn so far. + unsigned int ElemCount; // 4 // Number of indices (multiple of 3) to be rendered as triangles. Vertices are stored in the callee ImDrawList's vtx_buffer[] array, indices in idx_buffer[]. + ImDrawCallback UserCallback; // 4-8 // If != NULL, call the function instead of rendering the vertices. clip_rect and texture_id will be set normally. + void* UserCallbackData; // 4-8 // The draw callback code can access this. + + ImDrawCmd() { memset(this, 0, sizeof(*this)); } // Also ensure our padding fields are zeroed + + // Since 1.83: returns ImTextureID associated with this draw call. Warning: DO NOT assume this is always same as 'TextureId' (we will change this function for an upcoming feature) + inline ImTextureID GetTexID() const { return TextureId; } +}; + +// Vertex layout +#ifndef IMGUI_OVERRIDE_DRAWVERT_STRUCT_LAYOUT +struct ImDrawVert +{ + ImVec2 pos; + ImVec2 uv; + ImU32 col; +}; +#else +// You can override the vertex format layout by defining IMGUI_OVERRIDE_DRAWVERT_STRUCT_LAYOUT in imconfig.h +// The code expect ImVec2 pos (8 bytes), ImVec2 uv (8 bytes), ImU32 col (4 bytes), but you can re-order them or add other fields as needed to simplify integration in your engine. +// The type has to be described within the macro (you can either declare the struct or use a typedef). This is because ImVec2/ImU32 are likely not declared a the time you'd want to set your type up. +// NOTE: IMGUI DOESN'T CLEAR THE STRUCTURE AND DOESN'T CALL A CONSTRUCTOR SO ANY CUSTOM FIELD WILL BE UNINITIALIZED. IF YOU ADD EXTRA FIELDS (SUCH AS A 'Z' COORDINATES) YOU WILL NEED TO CLEAR THEM DURING RENDER OR TO IGNORE THEM. +IMGUI_OVERRIDE_DRAWVERT_STRUCT_LAYOUT; +#endif + +// [Internal] For use by ImDrawList +struct ImDrawCmdHeader +{ + ImVec4 ClipRect; + ImTextureID TextureId; + unsigned int VtxOffset; +}; + +// [Internal] For use by ImDrawListSplitter +struct ImDrawChannel +{ + ImVector _CmdBuffer; + ImVector _IdxBuffer; +}; + + +// Split/Merge functions are used to split the draw list into different layers which can be drawn into out of order. +// This is used by the Columns/Tables API, so items of each column can be batched together in a same draw call. +struct ImDrawListSplitter +{ + int _Current; // Current channel number (0) + int _Count; // Number of active channels (1+) + ImVector _Channels; // Draw channels (not resized down so _Count might be < Channels.Size) + + inline ImDrawListSplitter() { memset(this, 0, sizeof(*this)); } + inline ~ImDrawListSplitter() { ClearFreeMemory(); } + inline void Clear() { _Current = 0; _Count = 1; } // Do not clear Channels[] so our allocations are reused next frame + IMGUI_API void ClearFreeMemory(); + IMGUI_API void Split(ImDrawList* draw_list, int count); + IMGUI_API void Merge(ImDrawList* draw_list); + IMGUI_API void SetCurrentChannel(ImDrawList* draw_list, int channel_idx); +}; + +// Flags for ImDrawList functions +// (Legacy: bit 0 must always correspond to ImDrawFlags_Closed to be backward compatible with old API using a bool. Bits 1..3 must be unused) +enum ImDrawFlags_ +{ + ImDrawFlags_None = 0, + ImDrawFlags_Closed = 1 << 0, // PathStroke(), AddPolyline(): specify that shape should be closed (Important: this is always == 1 for legacy reason) + ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersTopLeft = 1 << 4, // AddRect(), AddRectFilled(), PathRect(): enable rounding top-left corner only (when rounding > 0.0f, we default to all corners). Was 0x01. + ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersTopRight = 1 << 5, // AddRect(), AddRectFilled(), PathRect(): enable rounding top-right corner only (when rounding > 0.0f, we default to all corners). Was 0x02. + ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersBottomLeft = 1 << 6, // AddRect(), AddRectFilled(), PathRect(): enable rounding bottom-left corner only (when rounding > 0.0f, we default to all corners). Was 0x04. + ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersBottomRight = 1 << 7, // AddRect(), AddRectFilled(), PathRect(): enable rounding bottom-right corner only (when rounding > 0.0f, we default to all corners). Wax 0x08. + ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersNone = 1 << 8, // AddRect(), AddRectFilled(), PathRect(): disable rounding on all corners (when rounding > 0.0f). This is NOT zero, NOT an implicit flag! + ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersTop = ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersTopLeft | ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersTopRight, + ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersBottom = ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersBottomLeft | ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersBottomRight, + ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersLeft = ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersBottomLeft | ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersTopLeft, + ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersRight = ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersBottomRight | ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersTopRight, + ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersAll = ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersTopLeft | ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersTopRight | ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersBottomLeft | ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersBottomRight, + ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersDefault_ = ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersAll, // Default to ALL corners if none of the _RoundCornersXX flags are specified. + ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersMask_ = ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersAll | ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersNone +}; + +// Flags for ImDrawList instance. Those are set automatically by ImGui:: functions from ImGuiIO settings, and generally not manipulated directly. +// It is however possible to temporarily alter flags between calls to ImDrawList:: functions. +enum ImDrawListFlags_ +{ + ImDrawListFlags_None = 0, + ImDrawListFlags_AntiAliasedLines = 1 << 0, // Enable anti-aliased lines/borders (*2 the number of triangles for 1.0f wide line or lines thin enough to be drawn using textures, otherwise *3 the number of triangles) + ImDrawListFlags_AntiAliasedLinesUseTex = 1 << 1, // Enable anti-aliased lines/borders using textures when possible. Require backend to render with bilinear filtering. + ImDrawListFlags_AntiAliasedFill = 1 << 2, // Enable anti-aliased edge around filled shapes (rounded rectangles, circles). + ImDrawListFlags_AllowVtxOffset = 1 << 3 // Can emit 'VtxOffset > 0' to allow large meshes. Set when 'ImGuiBackendFlags_RendererHasVtxOffset' is enabled. +}; + +// Draw command list +// This is the low-level list of polygons that ImGui:: functions are filling. At the end of the frame, +// all command lists are passed to your ImGuiIO::RenderDrawListFn function for rendering. +// Each dear imgui window contains its own ImDrawList. You can use ImGui::GetWindowDrawList() to +// access the current window draw list and draw custom primitives. +// You can interleave normal ImGui:: calls and adding primitives to the current draw list. +// In single viewport mode, top-left is == GetMainViewport()->Pos (generally 0,0), bottom-right is == GetMainViewport()->Pos+Size (generally io.DisplaySize). +// You are totally free to apply whatever transformation matrix to want to the data (depending on the use of the transformation you may want to apply it to ClipRect as well!) +// Important: Primitives are always added to the list and not culled (culling is done at higher-level by ImGui:: functions), if you use this API a lot consider coarse culling your drawn objects. +struct ImDrawList +{ + // This is what you have to render + ImVector CmdBuffer; // Draw commands. Typically 1 command = 1 GPU draw call, unless the command is a callback. + ImVector IdxBuffer; // Index buffer. Each command consume ImDrawCmd::ElemCount of those + ImVector VtxBuffer; // Vertex buffer. + ImDrawListFlags Flags; // Flags, you may poke into these to adjust anti-aliasing settings per-primitive. + + // [Internal, used while building lists] + unsigned int _VtxCurrentIdx; // [Internal] generally == VtxBuffer.Size unless we are past 64K vertices, in which case this gets reset to 0. + const ImDrawListSharedData* _Data; // Pointer to shared draw data (you can use ImGui::GetDrawListSharedData() to get the one from current ImGui context) + const char* _OwnerName; // Pointer to owner window's name for debugging + ImDrawVert* _VtxWritePtr; // [Internal] point within VtxBuffer.Data after each add command (to avoid using the ImVector<> operators too much) + ImDrawIdx* _IdxWritePtr; // [Internal] point within IdxBuffer.Data after each add command (to avoid using the ImVector<> operators too much) + ImVector _ClipRectStack; // [Internal] + ImVector _TextureIdStack; // [Internal] + ImVector _Path; // [Internal] current path building + ImDrawCmdHeader _CmdHeader; // [Internal] template of active commands. Fields should match those of CmdBuffer.back(). + ImDrawListSplitter _Splitter; // [Internal] for channels api (note: prefer using your own persistent instance of ImDrawListSplitter!) + float _FringeScale; // [Internal] anti-alias fringe is scaled by this value, this helps to keep things sharp while zooming at vertex buffer content + + // If you want to create ImDrawList instances, pass them ImGui::GetDrawListSharedData() or create and use your own ImDrawListSharedData (so you can use ImDrawList without ImGui) + ImDrawList(const ImDrawListSharedData* shared_data) { memset(this, 0, sizeof(*this)); _Data = shared_data; } + + ~ImDrawList() { _ClearFreeMemory(); } + IMGUI_API void PushClipRect(ImVec2 clip_rect_min, ImVec2 clip_rect_max, bool intersect_with_current_clip_rect = false); // Render-level scissoring. This is passed down to your render function but not used for CPU-side coarse clipping. Prefer using higher-level ImGui::PushClipRect() to affect logic (hit-testing and widget culling) + IMGUI_API void PushClipRectFullScreen(); + IMGUI_API void PopClipRect(); + IMGUI_API void PushTextureID(ImTextureID texture_id); + IMGUI_API void PopTextureID(); + inline ImVec2 GetClipRectMin() const { const ImVec4& cr = _ClipRectStack.back(); return ImVec2(cr.x, cr.y); } + inline ImVec2 GetClipRectMax() const { const ImVec4& cr = _ClipRectStack.back(); return ImVec2(cr.z, cr.w); } + + // Primitives + // - For rectangular primitives, "p_min" and "p_max" represent the upper-left and lower-right corners. + // - For circle primitives, use "num_segments == 0" to automatically calculate tessellation (preferred). + // In older versions (until Dear ImGui 1.77) the AddCircle functions defaulted to num_segments == 12. + // In future versions we will use textures to provide cheaper and higher-quality circles. + // Use AddNgon() and AddNgonFilled() functions if you need to guaranteed a specific number of sides. + IMGUI_API void AddLine(const ImVec2& p1, const ImVec2& p2, ImU32 col, float thickness = 1.0f); + IMGUI_API void AddRect(const ImVec2& p_min, const ImVec2& p_max, ImU32 col, float rounding = 0.0f, ImDrawFlags flags = 0, float thickness = 1.0f); // a: upper-left, b: lower-right (== upper-left + size) + IMGUI_API void AddRectFilled(const ImVec2& p_min, const ImVec2& p_max, ImU32 col, float rounding = 0.0f, ImDrawFlags flags = 0); // a: upper-left, b: lower-right (== upper-left + size) + IMGUI_API void AddRectFilledMultiColor(const ImVec2& p_min, const ImVec2& p_max, ImU32 col_upr_left, ImU32 col_upr_right, ImU32 col_bot_right, ImU32 col_bot_left); + IMGUI_API void AddQuad(const ImVec2& p1, const ImVec2& p2, const ImVec2& p3, const ImVec2& p4, ImU32 col, float thickness = 1.0f); + IMGUI_API void AddQuadFilled(const ImVec2& p1, const ImVec2& p2, const ImVec2& p3, const ImVec2& p4, ImU32 col); + IMGUI_API void AddTriangle(const ImVec2& p1, const ImVec2& p2, const ImVec2& p3, ImU32 col, float thickness = 1.0f); + IMGUI_API void AddTriangleFilled(const ImVec2& p1, const ImVec2& p2, const ImVec2& p3, ImU32 col); + IMGUI_API void AddCircle(const ImVec2& center, float radius, ImU32 col, int num_segments = 0, float thickness = 1.0f); + IMGUI_API void AddCircleFilled(const ImVec2& center, float radius, ImU32 col, int num_segments = 0); + IMGUI_API void AddNgon(const ImVec2& center, float radius, ImU32 col, int num_segments, float thickness = 1.0f); + IMGUI_API void AddNgonFilled(const ImVec2& center, float radius, ImU32 col, int num_segments); + IMGUI_API void AddText(const ImVec2& pos, ImU32 col, const char* text_begin, const char* text_end = NULL); + IMGUI_API void AddText(const ImFont* font, float font_size, const ImVec2& pos, ImU32 col, const char* text_begin, const char* text_end = NULL, float wrap_width = 0.0f, const ImVec4* cpu_fine_clip_rect = NULL); + IMGUI_API void AddPolyline(const ImVec2* points, int num_points, ImU32 col, ImDrawFlags flags, float thickness); + IMGUI_API void AddConvexPolyFilled(const ImVec2* points, int num_points, ImU32 col); // Note: Anti-aliased filling requires points to be in clockwise order. + IMGUI_API void AddBezierCubic(const ImVec2& p1, const ImVec2& p2, const ImVec2& p3, const ImVec2& p4, ImU32 col, float thickness, int num_segments = 0); // Cubic Bezier (4 control points) + IMGUI_API void AddBezierQuadratic(const ImVec2& p1, const ImVec2& p2, const ImVec2& p3, ImU32 col, float thickness, int num_segments = 0); // Quadratic Bezier (3 control points) + + // Image primitives + // - Read FAQ to understand what ImTextureID is. + // - "p_min" and "p_max" represent the upper-left and lower-right corners of the rectangle. + // - "uv_min" and "uv_max" represent the normalized texture coordinates to use for those corners. Using (0,0)->(1,1) texture coordinates will generally display the entire texture. + IMGUI_API void AddImage(ImTextureID user_texture_id, const ImVec2& p_min, const ImVec2& p_max, const ImVec2& uv_min = ImVec2(0, 0), const ImVec2& uv_max = ImVec2(1, 1), ImU32 col = IM_COL32_WHITE); + IMGUI_API void AddImageQuad(ImTextureID user_texture_id, const ImVec2& p1, const ImVec2& p2, const ImVec2& p3, const ImVec2& p4, const ImVec2& uv1 = ImVec2(0, 0), const ImVec2& uv2 = ImVec2(1, 0), const ImVec2& uv3 = ImVec2(1, 1), const ImVec2& uv4 = ImVec2(0, 1), ImU32 col = IM_COL32_WHITE); + IMGUI_API void AddImageRounded(ImTextureID user_texture_id, const ImVec2& p_min, const ImVec2& p_max, const ImVec2& uv_min, const ImVec2& uv_max, ImU32 col, float rounding, ImDrawFlags flags = 0); + + // Stateful path API, add points then finish with PathFillConvex() or PathStroke() + inline void PathClear() { _Path.Size = 0; } + inline void PathLineTo(const ImVec2& pos) { _Path.push_back(pos); } + inline void PathLineToMergeDuplicate(const ImVec2& pos) { if (_Path.Size == 0 || memcmp(&_Path.Data[_Path.Size - 1], &pos, 8) != 0) _Path.push_back(pos); } + inline void PathFillConvex(ImU32 col) { AddConvexPolyFilled(_Path.Data, _Path.Size, col); _Path.Size = 0; } // Note: Anti-aliased filling requires points to be in clockwise order. + inline void PathStroke(ImU32 col, ImDrawFlags flags = 0, float thickness = 1.0f) { AddPolyline(_Path.Data, _Path.Size, col, flags, thickness); _Path.Size = 0; } + IMGUI_API void PathArcTo(const ImVec2& center, float radius, float a_min, float a_max, int num_segments = 0); + IMGUI_API void PathArcToFast(const ImVec2& center, float radius, int a_min_of_12, int a_max_of_12); // Use precomputed angles for a 12 steps circle + IMGUI_API void PathBezierCubicCurveTo(const ImVec2& p2, const ImVec2& p3, const ImVec2& p4, int num_segments = 0); // Cubic Bezier (4 control points) + IMGUI_API void PathBezierQuadraticCurveTo(const ImVec2& p2, const ImVec2& p3, int num_segments = 0); // Quadratic Bezier (3 control points) + IMGUI_API void PathRect(const ImVec2& rect_min, const ImVec2& rect_max, float rounding = 0.0f, ImDrawFlags flags = 0); + + // Advanced + IMGUI_API void AddCallback(ImDrawCallback callback, void* callback_data); // Your rendering function must check for 'UserCallback' in ImDrawCmd and call the function instead of rendering triangles. + IMGUI_API void AddDrawCmd(); // This is useful if you need to forcefully create a new draw call (to allow for dependent rendering / blending). Otherwise primitives are merged into the same draw-call as much as possible + IMGUI_API ImDrawList* CloneOutput() const; // Create a clone of the CmdBuffer/IdxBuffer/VtxBuffer. + + // Advanced: Channels + // - Use to split render into layers. By switching channels to can render out-of-order (e.g. submit FG primitives before BG primitives) + // - Use to minimize draw calls (e.g. if going back-and-forth between multiple clipping rectangles, prefer to append into separate channels then merge at the end) + // - FIXME-OBSOLETE: This API shouldn't have been in ImDrawList in the first place! + // Prefer using your own persistent instance of ImDrawListSplitter as you can stack them. + // Using the ImDrawList::ChannelsXXXX you cannot stack a split over another. + inline void ChannelsSplit(int count) { _Splitter.Split(this, count); } + inline void ChannelsMerge() { _Splitter.Merge(this); } + inline void ChannelsSetCurrent(int n) { _Splitter.SetCurrentChannel(this, n); } + + // Advanced: Primitives allocations + // - We render triangles (three vertices) + // - All primitives needs to be reserved via PrimReserve() beforehand. + IMGUI_API void PrimReserve(int idx_count, int vtx_count); + IMGUI_API void PrimUnreserve(int idx_count, int vtx_count); + IMGUI_API void PrimRect(const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& b, ImU32 col); // Axis aligned rectangle (composed of two triangles) + IMGUI_API void PrimRectUV(const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& b, const ImVec2& uv_a, const ImVec2& uv_b, ImU32 col); + IMGUI_API void PrimQuadUV(const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& b, const ImVec2& c, const ImVec2& d, const ImVec2& uv_a, const ImVec2& uv_b, const ImVec2& uv_c, const ImVec2& uv_d, ImU32 col); + inline void PrimWriteVtx(const ImVec2& pos, const ImVec2& uv, ImU32 col) { _VtxWritePtr->pos = pos; _VtxWritePtr->uv = uv; _VtxWritePtr->col = col; _VtxWritePtr++; _VtxCurrentIdx++; } + inline void PrimWriteIdx(ImDrawIdx idx) { *_IdxWritePtr = idx; _IdxWritePtr++; } + inline void PrimVtx(const ImVec2& pos, const ImVec2& uv, ImU32 col) { PrimWriteIdx((ImDrawIdx)_VtxCurrentIdx); PrimWriteVtx(pos, uv, col); } // Write vertex with unique index + +#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_OBSOLETE_FUNCTIONS + inline void AddBezierCurve(const ImVec2& p1, const ImVec2& p2, const ImVec2& p3, const ImVec2& p4, ImU32 col, float thickness, int num_segments = 0) { AddBezierCubic(p1, p2, p3, p4, col, thickness, num_segments); } + inline void PathBezierCurveTo(const ImVec2& p2, const ImVec2& p3, const ImVec2& p4, int num_segments = 0) { PathBezierCubicCurveTo(p2, p3, p4, num_segments); } +#endif + + // [Internal helpers] + IMGUI_API void _ResetForNewFrame(); + IMGUI_API void _ClearFreeMemory(); + IMGUI_API void _PopUnusedDrawCmd(); + IMGUI_API void _TryMergeDrawCmds(); + IMGUI_API void _OnChangedClipRect(); + IMGUI_API void _OnChangedTextureID(); + IMGUI_API void _OnChangedVtxOffset(); + IMGUI_API int _CalcCircleAutoSegmentCount(float radius) const; + IMGUI_API void _PathArcToFastEx(const ImVec2& center, float radius, int a_min_sample, int a_max_sample, int a_step); + IMGUI_API void _PathArcToN(const ImVec2& center, float radius, float a_min, float a_max, int num_segments); +}; + +// All draw data to render a Dear ImGui frame +// (NB: the style and the naming convention here is a little inconsistent, we currently preserve them for backward compatibility purpose, +// as this is one of the oldest structure exposed by the library! Basically, ImDrawList == CmdList) +struct ImDrawData +{ + bool Valid; // Only valid after Render() is called and before the next NewFrame() is called. + int CmdListsCount; // Number of ImDrawList* to render + int TotalIdxCount; // For convenience, sum of all ImDrawList's IdxBuffer.Size + int TotalVtxCount; // For convenience, sum of all ImDrawList's VtxBuffer.Size + ImDrawList** CmdLists; // Array of ImDrawList* to render. The ImDrawList are owned by ImGuiContext and only pointed to from here. + ImVec2 DisplayPos; // Top-left position of the viewport to render (== top-left of the orthogonal projection matrix to use) (== GetMainViewport()->Pos for the main viewport, == (0.0) in most single-viewport applications) + ImVec2 DisplaySize; // Size of the viewport to render (== GetMainViewport()->Size for the main viewport, == io.DisplaySize in most single-viewport applications) + ImVec2 FramebufferScale; // Amount of pixels for each unit of DisplaySize. Based on io.DisplayFramebufferScale. Generally (1,1) on normal display, (2,2) on OSX with Retina display. + + // Functions + ImDrawData() { Clear(); } + void Clear() { memset(this, 0, sizeof(*this)); } // The ImDrawList are owned by ImGuiContext! + IMGUI_API void DeIndexAllBuffers(); // Helper to convert all buffers from indexed to non-indexed, in case you cannot render indexed. Note: this is slow and most likely a waste of resources. Always prefer indexed rendering! + IMGUI_API void ScaleClipRects(const ImVec2& fb_scale); // Helper to scale the ClipRect field of each ImDrawCmd. Use if your final output buffer is at a different scale than Dear ImGui expects, or if there is a difference between your window resolution and framebuffer resolution. +}; + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Font API (ImFontConfig, ImFontGlyph, ImFontAtlasFlags, ImFontAtlas, ImFontGlyphRangesBuilder, ImFont) +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +struct ImFontConfig +{ + void* FontData; // // TTF/OTF data + int FontDataSize; // // TTF/OTF data size + bool FontDataOwnedByAtlas; // true // TTF/OTF data ownership taken by the container ImFontAtlas (will delete memory itself). + int FontNo; // 0 // Index of font within TTF/OTF file + float SizePixels; // // Size in pixels for rasterizer (more or less maps to the resulting font height). + int OversampleH; // 3 // Rasterize at higher quality for sub-pixel positioning. Note the difference between 2 and 3 is minimal so you can reduce this to 2 to save memory. Read https://github.com/nothings/stb/blob/master/tests/oversample/README.md for details. + int OversampleV; // 1 // Rasterize at higher quality for sub-pixel positioning. This is not really useful as we don't use sub-pixel positions on the Y axis. + bool PixelSnapH; // false // Align every glyph to pixel boundary. Useful e.g. if you are merging a non-pixel aligned font with the default font. If enabled, you can set OversampleH/V to 1. + ImVec2 GlyphExtraSpacing; // 0, 0 // Extra spacing (in pixels) between glyphs. Only X axis is supported for now. + ImVec2 GlyphOffset; // 0, 0 // Offset all glyphs from this font input. + const ImWchar* GlyphRanges; // NULL // Pointer to a user-provided list of Unicode range (2 value per range, values are inclusive, zero-terminated list). THE ARRAY DATA NEEDS TO PERSIST AS LONG AS THE FONT IS ALIVE. + float GlyphMinAdvanceX; // 0 // Minimum AdvanceX for glyphs, set Min to align font icons, set both Min/Max to enforce mono-space font + float GlyphMaxAdvanceX; // FLT_MAX // Maximum AdvanceX for glyphs + bool MergeMode; // false // Merge into previous ImFont, so you can combine multiple inputs font into one ImFont (e.g. ASCII font + icons + Japanese glyphs). You may want to use GlyphOffset.y when merge font of different heights. + unsigned int FontBuilderFlags; // 0 // Settings for custom font builder. THIS IS BUILDER IMPLEMENTATION DEPENDENT. Leave as zero if unsure. + float RasterizerMultiply; // 1.0f // Brighten (>1.0f) or darken (<1.0f) font output. Brightening small fonts may be a good workaround to make them more readable. + ImWchar EllipsisChar; // -1 // Explicitly specify unicode codepoint of ellipsis character. When fonts are being merged first specified ellipsis will be used. + + // [Internal] + char Name[40]; // Name (strictly to ease debugging) + ImFont* DstFont; + + IMGUI_API ImFontConfig(); +}; + +// Hold rendering data for one glyph. +// (Note: some language parsers may fail to convert the 31+1 bitfield members, in this case maybe drop store a single u32 or we can rework this) +struct ImFontGlyph +{ + unsigned int Colored : 1; // Flag to indicate glyph is colored and should generally ignore tinting (make it usable with no shift on little-endian as this is used in loops) + unsigned int Visible : 1; // Flag to indicate glyph has no visible pixels (e.g. space). Allow early out when rendering. + unsigned int Codepoint : 30; // 0x0000..0x10FFFF + float AdvanceX; // Distance to next character (= data from font + ImFontConfig::GlyphExtraSpacing.x baked in) + float X0, Y0, X1, Y1; // Glyph corners + float U0, V0, U1, V1; // Texture coordinates +}; + +// Helper to build glyph ranges from text/string data. Feed your application strings/characters to it then call BuildRanges(). +// This is essentially a tightly packed of vector of 64k booleans = 8KB storage. +struct ImFontGlyphRangesBuilder +{ + ImVector UsedChars; // Store 1-bit per Unicode code point (0=unused, 1=used) + + ImFontGlyphRangesBuilder() { Clear(); } + inline void Clear() { int size_in_bytes = (IM_UNICODE_CODEPOINT_MAX + 1) / 8; UsedChars.resize(size_in_bytes / (int)sizeof(ImU32)); memset(UsedChars.Data, 0, (size_t)size_in_bytes); } + inline bool GetBit(size_t n) const { int off = (int)(n >> 5); ImU32 mask = 1u << (n & 31); return (UsedChars[off] & mask) != 0; } // Get bit n in the array + inline void SetBit(size_t n) { int off = (int)(n >> 5); ImU32 mask = 1u << (n & 31); UsedChars[off] |= mask; } // Set bit n in the array + inline void AddChar(ImWchar c) { SetBit(c); } // Add character + IMGUI_API void AddText(const char* text, const char* text_end = NULL); // Add string (each character of the UTF-8 string are added) + IMGUI_API void AddRanges(const ImWchar* ranges); // Add ranges, e.g. builder.AddRanges(ImFontAtlas::GetGlyphRangesDefault()) to force add all of ASCII/Latin+Ext + IMGUI_API void BuildRanges(ImVector* out_ranges); // Output new ranges +}; + +// See ImFontAtlas::AddCustomRectXXX functions. +struct ImFontAtlasCustomRect +{ + unsigned short Width, Height; // Input // Desired rectangle dimension + unsigned short X, Y; // Output // Packed position in Atlas + unsigned int GlyphID; // Input // For custom font glyphs only (ID < 0x110000) + float GlyphAdvanceX; // Input // For custom font glyphs only: glyph xadvance + ImVec2 GlyphOffset; // Input // For custom font glyphs only: glyph display offset + ImFont* Font; // Input // For custom font glyphs only: target font + ImFontAtlasCustomRect() { Width = Height = 0; X = Y = 0xFFFF; GlyphID = 0; GlyphAdvanceX = 0.0f; GlyphOffset = ImVec2(0, 0); Font = NULL; } + bool IsPacked() const { return X != 0xFFFF; } +}; + +// Flags for ImFontAtlas build +enum ImFontAtlasFlags_ +{ + ImFontAtlasFlags_None = 0, + ImFontAtlasFlags_NoPowerOfTwoHeight = 1 << 0, // Don't round the height to next power of two + ImFontAtlasFlags_NoMouseCursors = 1 << 1, // Don't build software mouse cursors into the atlas (save a little texture memory) + ImFontAtlasFlags_NoBakedLines = 1 << 2 // Don't build thick line textures into the atlas (save a little texture memory). The AntiAliasedLinesUseTex features uses them, otherwise they will be rendered using polygons (more expensive for CPU/GPU). +}; + +// Load and rasterize multiple TTF/OTF fonts into a same texture. The font atlas will build a single texture holding: +// - One or more fonts. +// - Custom graphics data needed to render the shapes needed by Dear ImGui. +// - Mouse cursor shapes for software cursor rendering (unless setting 'Flags |= ImFontAtlasFlags_NoMouseCursors' in the font atlas). +// It is the user-code responsibility to setup/build the atlas, then upload the pixel data into a texture accessible by your graphics api. +// - Optionally, call any of the AddFont*** functions. If you don't call any, the default font embedded in the code will be loaded for you. +// - Call GetTexDataAsAlpha8() or GetTexDataAsRGBA32() to build and retrieve pixels data. +// - Upload the pixels data into a texture within your graphics system (see imgui_impl_xxxx.cpp examples) +// - Call SetTexID(my_tex_id); and pass the pointer/identifier to your texture in a format natural to your graphics API. +// This value will be passed back to you during rendering to identify the texture. Read FAQ entry about ImTextureID for more details. +// Common pitfalls: +// - If you pass a 'glyph_ranges' array to AddFont*** functions, you need to make sure that your array persist up until the +// atlas is build (when calling GetTexData*** or Build()). We only copy the pointer, not the data. +// - Important: By default, AddFontFromMemoryTTF() takes ownership of the data. Even though we are not writing to it, we will free the pointer on destruction. +// You can set font_cfg->FontDataOwnedByAtlas=false to keep ownership of your data and it won't be freed, +// - Even though many functions are suffixed with "TTF", OTF data is supported just as well. +// - This is an old API and it is currently awkward for those and and various other reasons! We will address them in the future! +struct ImFontAtlas +{ + IMGUI_API ImFontAtlas(); + IMGUI_API ~ImFontAtlas(); + IMGUI_API ImFont* AddFont(const ImFontConfig* font_cfg); + IMGUI_API ImFont* AddFontDefault(const ImFontConfig* font_cfg = NULL); + IMGUI_API ImFont* AddFontFromFileTTF(const char* filename, float size_pixels, const ImFontConfig* font_cfg = NULL, const ImWchar* glyph_ranges = NULL); + IMGUI_API ImFont* AddFontFromMemoryTTF(void* font_data, int font_size, float size_pixels, const ImFontConfig* font_cfg = NULL, const ImWchar* glyph_ranges = NULL); // Note: Transfer ownership of 'ttf_data' to ImFontAtlas! Will be deleted after destruction of the atlas. Set font_cfg->FontDataOwnedByAtlas=false to keep ownership of your data and it won't be freed. + IMGUI_API ImFont* AddFontFromMemoryCompressedTTF(const void* compressed_font_data, int compressed_font_size, float size_pixels, const ImFontConfig* font_cfg = NULL, const ImWchar* glyph_ranges = NULL); // 'compressed_font_data' still owned by caller. Compress with binary_to_compressed_c.cpp. + IMGUI_API ImFont* AddFontFromMemoryCompressedBase85TTF(const char* compressed_font_data_base85, float size_pixels, const ImFontConfig* font_cfg = NULL, const ImWchar* glyph_ranges = NULL); // 'compressed_font_data_base85' still owned by caller. Compress with binary_to_compressed_c.cpp with -base85 parameter. + IMGUI_API void ClearInputData(); // Clear input data (all ImFontConfig structures including sizes, TTF data, glyph ranges, etc.) = all the data used to build the texture and fonts. + IMGUI_API void ClearTexData(); // Clear output texture data (CPU side). Saves RAM once the texture has been copied to graphics memory. + IMGUI_API void ClearFonts(); // Clear output font data (glyphs storage, UV coordinates). + IMGUI_API void Clear(); // Clear all input and output. + + // Build atlas, retrieve pixel data. + // User is in charge of copying the pixels into graphics memory (e.g. create a texture with your engine). Then store your texture handle with SetTexID(). + // The pitch is always = Width * BytesPerPixels (1 or 4) + // Building in RGBA32 format is provided for convenience and compatibility, but note that unless you manually manipulate or copy color data into + // the texture (e.g. when using the AddCustomRect*** api), then the RGB pixels emitted will always be white (~75% of memory/bandwidth waste. + IMGUI_API bool Build(); // Build pixels data. This is called automatically for you by the GetTexData*** functions. + IMGUI_API void GetTexDataAsAlpha8(unsigned char** out_pixels, int* out_width, int* out_height, int* out_bytes_per_pixel = NULL); // 1 byte per-pixel + IMGUI_API void GetTexDataAsRGBA32(unsigned char** out_pixels, int* out_width, int* out_height, int* out_bytes_per_pixel = NULL); // 4 bytes-per-pixel + bool IsBuilt() const { return Fonts.Size > 0 && TexReady; } // Bit ambiguous: used to detect when user didn't built texture but effectively we should check TexID != 0 except that would be backend dependent... + void SetTexID(ImTextureID id) { TexID = id; } + + //------------------------------------------- + // Glyph Ranges + //------------------------------------------- + + // Helpers to retrieve list of common Unicode ranges (2 value per range, values are inclusive, zero-terminated list) + // NB: Make sure that your string are UTF-8 and NOT in your local code page. In C++11, you can create UTF-8 string literal using the u8"Hello world" syntax. See FAQ for details. + // NB: Consider using ImFontGlyphRangesBuilder to build glyph ranges from textual data. + IMGUI_API const ImWchar* GetGlyphRangesDefault(); // Basic Latin, Extended Latin + IMGUI_API const ImWchar* GetGlyphRangesKorean(); // Default + Korean characters + IMGUI_API const ImWchar* GetGlyphRangesJapanese(); // Default + Hiragana, Katakana, Half-Width, Selection of 2999 Ideographs + IMGUI_API const ImWchar* GetGlyphRangesChineseFull(); // Default + Half-Width + Japanese Hiragana/Katakana + full set of about 21000 CJK Unified Ideographs + IMGUI_API const ImWchar* GetGlyphRangesChineseSimplifiedCommon();// Default + Half-Width + Japanese Hiragana/Katakana + set of 2500 CJK Unified Ideographs for common simplified Chinese + IMGUI_API const ImWchar* GetGlyphRangesCyrillic(); // Default + about 400 Cyrillic characters + IMGUI_API const ImWchar* GetGlyphRangesThai(); // Default + Thai characters + IMGUI_API const ImWchar* GetGlyphRangesVietnamese(); // Default + Vietnamese characters + + //------------------------------------------- + // [BETA] Custom Rectangles/Glyphs API + //------------------------------------------- + + // You can request arbitrary rectangles to be packed into the atlas, for your own purposes. + // - After calling Build(), you can query the rectangle position and render your pixels. + // - If you render colored output, set 'atlas->TexPixelsUseColors = true' as this may help some backends decide of prefered texture format. + // - You can also request your rectangles to be mapped as font glyph (given a font + Unicode point), + // so you can render e.g. custom colorful icons and use them as regular glyphs. + // - Read docs/FONTS.md for more details about using colorful icons. + // - Note: this API may be redesigned later in order to support multi-monitor varying DPI settings. + IMGUI_API int AddCustomRectRegular(int width, int height); + IMGUI_API int AddCustomRectFontGlyph(ImFont* font, ImWchar id, int width, int height, float advance_x, const ImVec2& offset = ImVec2(0, 0)); + ImFontAtlasCustomRect* GetCustomRectByIndex(int index) { IM_ASSERT(index >= 0); return &CustomRects[index]; } + + // [Internal] + IMGUI_API void CalcCustomRectUV(const ImFontAtlasCustomRect* rect, ImVec2* out_uv_min, ImVec2* out_uv_max) const; + IMGUI_API bool GetMouseCursorTexData(ImGuiMouseCursor cursor, ImVec2* out_offset, ImVec2* out_size, ImVec2 out_uv_border[2], ImVec2 out_uv_fill[2]); + + //------------------------------------------- + // Members + //------------------------------------------- + + ImFontAtlasFlags Flags; // Build flags (see ImFontAtlasFlags_) + ImTextureID TexID; // User data to refer to the texture once it has been uploaded to user's graphic systems. It is passed back to you during rendering via the ImDrawCmd structure. + int TexDesiredWidth; // Texture width desired by user before Build(). Must be a power-of-two. If have many glyphs your graphics API have texture size restrictions you may want to increase texture width to decrease height. + int TexGlyphPadding; // Padding between glyphs within texture in pixels. Defaults to 1. If your rendering method doesn't rely on bilinear filtering you may set this to 0. + bool Locked; // Marked as Locked by ImGui::NewFrame() so attempt to modify the atlas will assert. + + // [Internal] + // NB: Access texture data via GetTexData*() calls! Which will setup a default font for you. + bool TexReady; // Set when texture was built matching current font input + bool TexPixelsUseColors; // Tell whether our texture data is known to use colors (rather than just alpha channel), in order to help backend select a format. + unsigned char* TexPixelsAlpha8; // 1 component per pixel, each component is unsigned 8-bit. Total size = TexWidth * TexHeight + unsigned int* TexPixelsRGBA32; // 4 component per pixel, each component is unsigned 8-bit. Total size = TexWidth * TexHeight * 4 + int TexWidth; // Texture width calculated during Build(). + int TexHeight; // Texture height calculated during Build(). + ImVec2 TexUvScale; // = (1.0f/TexWidth, 1.0f/TexHeight) + ImVec2 TexUvWhitePixel; // Texture coordinates to a white pixel + ImVector Fonts; // Hold all the fonts returned by AddFont*. Fonts[0] is the default font upon calling ImGui::NewFrame(), use ImGui::PushFont()/PopFont() to change the current font. + ImVector CustomRects; // Rectangles for packing custom texture data into the atlas. + ImVector ConfigData; // Configuration data + ImVec4 TexUvLines[IM_DRAWLIST_TEX_LINES_WIDTH_MAX + 1]; // UVs for baked anti-aliased lines + + // [Internal] Font builder + const ImFontBuilderIO* FontBuilderIO; // Opaque interface to a font builder (default to stb_truetype, can be changed to use FreeType by defining IMGUI_ENABLE_FREETYPE). + unsigned int FontBuilderFlags; // Shared flags (for all fonts) for custom font builder. THIS IS BUILD IMPLEMENTATION DEPENDENT. Per-font override is also available in ImFontConfig. + + // [Internal] Packing data + int PackIdMouseCursors; // Custom texture rectangle ID for white pixel and mouse cursors + int PackIdLines; // Custom texture rectangle ID for baked anti-aliased lines + +#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_OBSOLETE_FUNCTIONS + typedef ImFontAtlasCustomRect CustomRect; // OBSOLETED in 1.72+ + //typedef ImFontGlyphRangesBuilder GlyphRangesBuilder; // OBSOLETED in 1.67+ +#endif +}; + +// Font runtime data and rendering +// ImFontAtlas automatically loads a default embedded font for you when you call GetTexDataAsAlpha8() or GetTexDataAsRGBA32(). +struct ImFont +{ + // Members: Hot ~20/24 bytes (for CalcTextSize) + ImVector IndexAdvanceX; // 12-16 // out // // Sparse. Glyphs->AdvanceX in a directly indexable way (cache-friendly for CalcTextSize functions which only this this info, and are often bottleneck in large UI). + float FallbackAdvanceX; // 4 // out // = FallbackGlyph->AdvanceX + float FontSize; // 4 // in // // Height of characters/line, set during loading (don't change after loading) + + // Members: Hot ~28/40 bytes (for CalcTextSize + render loop) + ImVector IndexLookup; // 12-16 // out // // Sparse. Index glyphs by Unicode code-point. + ImVector Glyphs; // 12-16 // out // // All glyphs. + const ImFontGlyph* FallbackGlyph; // 4-8 // out // = FindGlyph(FontFallbackChar) + + // Members: Cold ~32/40 bytes + ImFontAtlas* ContainerAtlas; // 4-8 // out // // What we has been loaded into + const ImFontConfig* ConfigData; // 4-8 // in // // Pointer within ContainerAtlas->ConfigData + short ConfigDataCount; // 2 // in // ~ 1 // Number of ImFontConfig involved in creating this font. Bigger than 1 when merging multiple font sources into one ImFont. + ImWchar FallbackChar; // 2 // out // = FFFD/'?' // Character used if a glyph isn't found. + ImWchar EllipsisChar; // 2 // out // = '...' // Character used for ellipsis rendering. + ImWchar DotChar; // 2 // out // = '.' // Character used for ellipsis rendering (if a single '...' character isn't found) + bool DirtyLookupTables; // 1 // out // + float Scale; // 4 // in // = 1.f // Base font scale, multiplied by the per-window font scale which you can adjust with SetWindowFontScale() + float Ascent, Descent; // 4+4 // out // // Ascent: distance from top to bottom of e.g. 'A' [0..FontSize] + int MetricsTotalSurface;// 4 // out // // Total surface in pixels to get an idea of the font rasterization/texture cost (not exact, we approximate the cost of padding between glyphs) + ImU8 Used4kPagesMap[(IM_UNICODE_CODEPOINT_MAX+1)/4096/8]; // 2 bytes if ImWchar=ImWchar16, 34 bytes if ImWchar==ImWchar32. Store 1-bit for each block of 4K codepoints that has one active glyph. This is mainly used to facilitate iterations across all used codepoints. + + // Methods + IMGUI_API ImFont(); + IMGUI_API ~ImFont(); + IMGUI_API const ImFontGlyph*FindGlyph(ImWchar c) const; + IMGUI_API const ImFontGlyph*FindGlyphNoFallback(ImWchar c) const; + float GetCharAdvance(ImWchar c) const { return ((int)c < IndexAdvanceX.Size) ? IndexAdvanceX[(int)c] : FallbackAdvanceX; } + bool IsLoaded() const { return ContainerAtlas != NULL; } + const char* GetDebugName() const { return ConfigData ? ConfigData->Name : ""; } + + // 'max_width' stops rendering after a certain width (could be turned into a 2d size). FLT_MAX to disable. + // 'wrap_width' enable automatic word-wrapping across multiple lines to fit into given width. 0.0f to disable. + IMGUI_API ImVec2 CalcTextSizeA(float size, float max_width, float wrap_width, const char* text_begin, const char* text_end = NULL, const char** remaining = NULL) const; // utf8 + IMGUI_API const char* CalcWordWrapPositionA(float scale, const char* text, const char* text_end, float wrap_width) const; + IMGUI_API void RenderChar(ImDrawList* draw_list, float size, ImVec2 pos, ImU32 col, ImWchar c) const; + IMGUI_API void RenderText(ImDrawList* draw_list, float size, ImVec2 pos, ImU32 col, const ImVec4& clip_rect, const char* text_begin, const char* text_end, float wrap_width = 0.0f, bool cpu_fine_clip = false) const; + + // [Internal] Don't use! + IMGUI_API void BuildLookupTable(); + IMGUI_API void ClearOutputData(); + IMGUI_API void GrowIndex(int new_size); + IMGUI_API void AddGlyph(const ImFontConfig* src_cfg, ImWchar c, float x0, float y0, float x1, float y1, float u0, float v0, float u1, float v1, float advance_x); + IMGUI_API void AddRemapChar(ImWchar dst, ImWchar src, bool overwrite_dst = true); // Makes 'dst' character/glyph points to 'src' character/glyph. Currently needs to be called AFTER fonts have been built. + IMGUI_API void SetGlyphVisible(ImWchar c, bool visible); + IMGUI_API bool IsGlyphRangeUnused(unsigned int c_begin, unsigned int c_last); +}; + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Viewports +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// Flags stored in ImGuiViewport::Flags, giving indications to the platform backends. +enum ImGuiViewportFlags_ +{ + ImGuiViewportFlags_None = 0, + ImGuiViewportFlags_IsPlatformWindow = 1 << 0, // Represent a Platform Window + ImGuiViewportFlags_IsPlatformMonitor = 1 << 1, // Represent a Platform Monitor (unused yet) + ImGuiViewportFlags_OwnedByApp = 1 << 2 // Platform Window: is created/managed by the application (rather than a dear imgui backend) +}; + +// - Currently represents the Platform Window created by the application which is hosting our Dear ImGui windows. +// - In 'docking' branch with multi-viewport enabled, we extend this concept to have multiple active viewports. +// - In the future we will extend this concept further to also represent Platform Monitor and support a "no main platform window" operation mode. +// - About Main Area vs Work Area: +// - Main Area = entire viewport. +// - Work Area = entire viewport minus sections used by main menu bars (for platform windows), or by task bar (for platform monitor). +// - Windows are generally trying to stay within the Work Area of their host viewport. +struct ImGuiViewport +{ + ImGuiViewportFlags Flags; // See ImGuiViewportFlags_ + ImVec2 Pos; // Main Area: Position of the viewport (Dear ImGui coordinates are the same as OS desktop/native coordinates) + ImVec2 Size; // Main Area: Size of the viewport. + ImVec2 WorkPos; // Work Area: Position of the viewport minus task bars, menus bars, status bars (>= Pos) + ImVec2 WorkSize; // Work Area: Size of the viewport minus task bars, menu bars, status bars (<= Size) + + ImGuiViewport() { memset(this, 0, sizeof(*this)); } + + // Helpers + ImVec2 GetCenter() const { return ImVec2(Pos.x + Size.x * 0.5f, Pos.y + Size.y * 0.5f); } + ImVec2 GetWorkCenter() const { return ImVec2(WorkPos.x + WorkSize.x * 0.5f, WorkPos.y + WorkSize.y * 0.5f); } +}; + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Obsolete functions and types +// (Will be removed! Read 'API BREAKING CHANGES' section in imgui.cpp for details) +// Please keep your copy of dear imgui up to date! Occasionally set '#define IMGUI_DISABLE_OBSOLETE_FUNCTIONS' in imconfig.h to stay ahead. +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_OBSOLETE_FUNCTIONS +namespace ImGui +{ + // OBSOLETED in 1.81 (from February 2021) + IMGUI_API bool ListBoxHeader(const char* label, int items_count, int height_in_items = -1); // Helper to calculate size from items_count and height_in_items + static inline bool ListBoxHeader(const char* label, const ImVec2& size = ImVec2(0, 0)) { return BeginListBox(label, size); } + static inline void ListBoxFooter() { EndListBox(); } + // OBSOLETED in 1.79 (from August 2020) + static inline void OpenPopupContextItem(const char* str_id = NULL, ImGuiMouseButton mb = 1) { OpenPopupOnItemClick(str_id, mb); } // Bool return value removed. Use IsWindowAppearing() in BeginPopup() instead. Renamed in 1.77, renamed back in 1.79. Sorry! + // OBSOLETED in 1.78 (from June 2020) + // Old drag/sliders functions that took a 'float power = 1.0' argument instead of flags. + // For shared code, you can version check at compile-time with `#if IMGUI_VERSION_NUM >= 17704`. + IMGUI_API bool DragScalar(const char* label, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* p_data, float v_speed, const void* p_min, const void* p_max, const char* format, float power); + IMGUI_API bool DragScalarN(const char* label, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* p_data, int components, float v_speed, const void* p_min, const void* p_max, const char* format, float power); + static inline bool DragFloat(const char* label, float* v, float v_speed, float v_min, float v_max, const char* format, float power) { return DragScalar(label, ImGuiDataType_Float, v, v_speed, &v_min, &v_max, format, power); } + static inline bool DragFloat2(const char* label, float v[2], float v_speed, float v_min, float v_max, const char* format, float power) { return DragScalarN(label, ImGuiDataType_Float, v, 2, v_speed, &v_min, &v_max, format, power); } + static inline bool DragFloat3(const char* label, float v[3], float v_speed, float v_min, float v_max, const char* format, float power) { return DragScalarN(label, ImGuiDataType_Float, v, 3, v_speed, &v_min, &v_max, format, power); } + static inline bool DragFloat4(const char* label, float v[4], float v_speed, float v_min, float v_max, const char* format, float power) { return DragScalarN(label, ImGuiDataType_Float, v, 4, v_speed, &v_min, &v_max, format, power); } + IMGUI_API bool SliderScalar(const char* label, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* p_data, const void* p_min, const void* p_max, const char* format, float power); + IMGUI_API bool SliderScalarN(const char* label, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* p_data, int components, const void* p_min, const void* p_max, const char* format, float power); + static inline bool SliderFloat(const char* label, float* v, float v_min, float v_max, const char* format, float power) { return SliderScalar(label, ImGuiDataType_Float, v, &v_min, &v_max, format, power); } + static inline bool SliderFloat2(const char* label, float v[2], float v_min, float v_max, const char* format, float power) { return SliderScalarN(label, ImGuiDataType_Float, v, 2, &v_min, &v_max, format, power); } + static inline bool SliderFloat3(const char* label, float v[3], float v_min, float v_max, const char* format, float power) { return SliderScalarN(label, ImGuiDataType_Float, v, 3, &v_min, &v_max, format, power); } + static inline bool SliderFloat4(const char* label, float v[4], float v_min, float v_max, const char* format, float power) { return SliderScalarN(label, ImGuiDataType_Float, v, 4, &v_min, &v_max, format, power); } + // OBSOLETED in 1.77 (from June 2020) + static inline bool BeginPopupContextWindow(const char* str_id, ImGuiMouseButton mb, bool over_items) { return BeginPopupContextWindow(str_id, mb | (over_items ? 0 : ImGuiPopupFlags_NoOpenOverItems)); } + // OBSOLETED in 1.72 (from April 2019) + static inline void TreeAdvanceToLabelPos() { SetCursorPosX(GetCursorPosX() + GetTreeNodeToLabelSpacing()); } + // OBSOLETED in 1.71 (from June 2019) + static inline void SetNextTreeNodeOpen(bool open, ImGuiCond cond = 0) { SetNextItemOpen(open, cond); } + // OBSOLETED in 1.70 (from May 2019) + static inline float GetContentRegionAvailWidth() { return GetContentRegionAvail().x; } + + // Some of the older obsolete names along with their replacement (commented out so they are not reported in IDE) + //static inline ImDrawList* GetOverlayDrawList() { return GetForegroundDrawList(); } // OBSOLETED in 1.69 (from Mar 2019) + //static inline void SetScrollHere(float ratio = 0.5f) { SetScrollHereY(ratio); } // OBSOLETED in 1.66 (from Nov 2018) + //static inline bool IsItemDeactivatedAfterChange() { return IsItemDeactivatedAfterEdit(); } // OBSOLETED in 1.63 (from Aug 2018) + //static inline bool IsAnyWindowFocused() { return IsWindowFocused(ImGuiFocusedFlags_AnyWindow); } // OBSOLETED in 1.60 (from Apr 2018) + //static inline bool IsAnyWindowHovered() { return IsWindowHovered(ImGuiHoveredFlags_AnyWindow); } // OBSOLETED in 1.60 (between Dec 2017 and Apr 2018) + //static inline void ShowTestWindow() { return ShowDemoWindow(); } // OBSOLETED in 1.53 (between Oct 2017 and Dec 2017) + //static inline bool IsRootWindowFocused() { return IsWindowFocused(ImGuiFocusedFlags_RootWindow); } // OBSOLETED in 1.53 (between Oct 2017 and Dec 2017) + //static inline bool IsRootWindowOrAnyChildFocused() { return IsWindowFocused(ImGuiFocusedFlags_RootAndChildWindows); } // OBSOLETED in 1.53 (between Oct 2017 and Dec 2017) + //static inline void SetNextWindowContentWidth(float w) { SetNextWindowContentSize(ImVec2(w, 0.0f)); } // OBSOLETED in 1.53 (between Oct 2017 and Dec 2017) + //static inline float GetItemsLineHeightWithSpacing() { return GetFrameHeightWithSpacing(); } // OBSOLETED in 1.53 (between Oct 2017 and Dec 2017) +} + +// OBSOLETED in 1.82 (from Mars 2021): flags for AddRect(), AddRectFilled(), AddImageRounded(), PathRect() +typedef ImDrawFlags ImDrawCornerFlags; +enum ImDrawCornerFlags_ +{ + ImDrawCornerFlags_None = ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersNone, // Was == 0 prior to 1.82, this is now == ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersNone which is != 0 and not implicit + ImDrawCornerFlags_TopLeft = ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersTopLeft, // Was == 0x01 (1 << 0) prior to 1.82. Order matches ImDrawFlags_NoRoundCorner* flag (we exploit this internally). + ImDrawCornerFlags_TopRight = ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersTopRight, // Was == 0x02 (1 << 1) prior to 1.82. + ImDrawCornerFlags_BotLeft = ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersBottomLeft, // Was == 0x04 (1 << 2) prior to 1.82. + ImDrawCornerFlags_BotRight = ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersBottomRight, // Was == 0x08 (1 << 3) prior to 1.82. + ImDrawCornerFlags_All = ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersAll, // Was == 0x0F prior to 1.82 + ImDrawCornerFlags_Top = ImDrawCornerFlags_TopLeft | ImDrawCornerFlags_TopRight, + ImDrawCornerFlags_Bot = ImDrawCornerFlags_BotLeft | ImDrawCornerFlags_BotRight, + ImDrawCornerFlags_Left = ImDrawCornerFlags_TopLeft | ImDrawCornerFlags_BotLeft, + ImDrawCornerFlags_Right = ImDrawCornerFlags_TopRight | ImDrawCornerFlags_BotRight +}; + +#endif // #ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_OBSOLETE_FUNCTIONS + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +#if defined(__clang__) +#pragma clang diagnostic pop +#elif defined(__GNUC__) +#pragma GCC diagnostic pop +#endif + +#ifdef _MSC_VER +#pragma warning (pop) +#endif + +// Include imgui_user.h at the end of imgui.h (convenient for user to only explicitly include vanilla imgui.h) +#ifdef IMGUI_INCLUDE_IMGUI_USER_H +#include "imgui_user.h" +#endif + +#endif // #ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE diff --git a/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/imgui-1.84.2/imgui_demo.cpp b/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/imgui-1.84.2/imgui_demo.cpp new file mode 100644 index 0000000..d75989d --- /dev/null +++ b/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/imgui-1.84.2/imgui_demo.cpp @@ -0,0 +1,7651 @@ +// dear imgui, v1.84 +// (demo code) + +// Help: +// - Read FAQ at http://dearimgui.org/faq +// - Newcomers, read 'Programmer guide' in imgui.cpp for notes on how to setup Dear ImGui in your codebase. +// - Call and read ImGui::ShowDemoWindow() in imgui_demo.cpp. All applications in examples/ are doing that. +// Read imgui.cpp for more details, documentation and comments. +// Get the latest version at https://github.com/ocornut/imgui + +// Message to the person tempted to delete this file when integrating Dear ImGui into their codebase: +// Do NOT remove this file from your project! Think again! It is the most useful reference code that you and other +// coders will want to refer to and call. Have the ImGui::ShowDemoWindow() function wired in an always-available +// debug menu of your game/app! Removing this file from your project is hindering access to documentation for everyone +// in your team, likely leading you to poorer usage of the library. +// Everything in this file will be stripped out by the linker if you don't call ImGui::ShowDemoWindow(). +// If you want to link core Dear ImGui in your shipped builds but want a thorough guarantee that the demo will not be +// linked, you can setup your imconfig.h with #define IMGUI_DISABLE_DEMO_WINDOWS and those functions will be empty. +// In another situation, whenever you have Dear ImGui available you probably want this to be available for reference. +// Thank you, +// -Your beloved friend, imgui_demo.cpp (which you won't delete) + +// Message to beginner C/C++ programmers about the meaning of the 'static' keyword: +// In this demo code, we frequently use 'static' variables inside functions. A static variable persists across calls, +// so it is essentially like a global variable but declared inside the scope of the function. We do this as a way to +// gather code and data in the same place, to make the demo source code faster to read, faster to write, and smaller +// in size. It also happens to be a convenient way of storing simple UI related information as long as your function +// doesn't need to be reentrant or used in multiple threads. This might be a pattern you will want to use in your code, +// but most of the real data you would be editing is likely going to be stored outside your functions. + +// The Demo code in this file is designed to be easy to copy-and-paste into your application! +// Because of this: +// - We never omit the ImGui:: prefix when calling functions, even though most code here is in the same namespace. +// - We try to declare static variables in the local scope, as close as possible to the code using them. +// - We never use any of the helpers/facilities used internally by Dear ImGui, unless available in the public API. +// - We never use maths operators on ImVec2/ImVec4. For our other sources files we use them, and they are provided +// by imgui_internal.h using the IMGUI_DEFINE_MATH_OPERATORS define. For your own sources file they are optional +// and require you either enable those, either provide your own via IM_VEC2_CLASS_EXTRA in imconfig.h. +// Because we can't assume anything about your support of maths operators, we cannot use them in imgui_demo.cpp. + +// Navigating this file: +// - In Visual Studio IDE: CTRL+comma ("Edit.NavigateTo") can follow symbols in comments, whereas CTRL+F12 ("Edit.GoToImplementation") cannot. +// - With Visual Assist installed: ALT+G ("VAssistX.GoToImplementation") can also follow symbols in comments. + +/* + +Index of this file: + +// [SECTION] Forward Declarations, Helpers +// [SECTION] Demo Window / ShowDemoWindow() +// - sub section: ShowDemoWindowWidgets() +// - sub section: ShowDemoWindowLayout() +// - sub section: ShowDemoWindowPopups() +// - sub section: ShowDemoWindowTables() +// - sub section: ShowDemoWindowMisc() +// [SECTION] About Window / ShowAboutWindow() +// [SECTION] Style Editor / ShowStyleEditor() +// [SECTION] Example App: Main Menu Bar / ShowExampleAppMainMenuBar() +// [SECTION] Example App: Debug Console / ShowExampleAppConsole() +// [SECTION] Example App: Debug Log / ShowExampleAppLog() +// [SECTION] Example App: Simple Layout / ShowExampleAppLayout() +// [SECTION] Example App: Property Editor / ShowExampleAppPropertyEditor() +// [SECTION] Example App: Long Text / ShowExampleAppLongText() +// [SECTION] Example App: Auto Resize / ShowExampleAppAutoResize() +// [SECTION] Example App: Constrained Resize / ShowExampleAppConstrainedResize() +// [SECTION] Example App: Simple overlay / ShowExampleAppSimpleOverlay() +// [SECTION] Example App: Fullscreen window / ShowExampleAppFullscreen() +// [SECTION] Example App: Manipulating window titles / ShowExampleAppWindowTitles() +// [SECTION] Example App: Custom Rendering using ImDrawList API / ShowExampleAppCustomRendering() +// [SECTION] Example App: Documents Handling / ShowExampleAppDocuments() + +*/ + +#if defined(_MSC_VER) && !defined(_CRT_SECURE_NO_WARNINGS) +#define _CRT_SECURE_NO_WARNINGS +#endif + +#include "imgui.h" +#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE + +// System includes +#include // toupper +#include // INT_MIN, INT_MAX +#include // sqrtf, powf, cosf, sinf, floorf, ceilf +#include // vsnprintf, sscanf, printf +#include // NULL, malloc, free, atoi +#if defined(_MSC_VER) && _MSC_VER <= 1500 // MSVC 2008 or earlier +#include // intptr_t +#else +#include // intptr_t +#endif + +// Visual Studio warnings +#ifdef _MSC_VER +#pragma warning (disable: 4996) // 'This function or variable may be unsafe': strcpy, strdup, sprintf, vsnprintf, sscanf, fopen +#pragma warning (disable: 26451) // [Static Analyzer] Arithmetic overflow : Using operator 'xxx' on a 4 byte value and then casting the result to a 8 byte value. Cast the value to the wider type before calling operator 'xxx' to avoid overflow(io.2). +#endif + +// Clang/GCC warnings with -Weverything +#if defined(__clang__) +#if __has_warning("-Wunknown-warning-option") +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wunknown-warning-option" // warning: unknown warning group 'xxx' // not all warnings are known by all Clang versions and they tend to be rename-happy.. so ignoring warnings triggers new warnings on some configuration. Great! +#endif +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wunknown-pragmas" // warning: unknown warning group 'xxx' +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wold-style-cast" // warning: use of old-style cast // yes, they are more terse. +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wdeprecated-declarations" // warning: 'xx' is deprecated: The POSIX name for this.. // for strdup used in demo code (so user can copy & paste the code) +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wint-to-void-pointer-cast" // warning: cast to 'void *' from smaller integer type +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wformat-security" // warning: format string is not a string literal +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wexit-time-destructors" // warning: declaration requires an exit-time destructor // exit-time destruction order is undefined. if MemFree() leads to users code that has been disabled before exit it might cause problems. ImGui coding style welcomes static/globals. +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wunused-macros" // warning: macro is not used // we define snprintf/vsnprintf on Windows so they are available, but not always used. +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wzero-as-null-pointer-constant" // warning: zero as null pointer constant // some standard header variations use #define NULL 0 +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wdouble-promotion" // warning: implicit conversion from 'float' to 'double' when passing argument to function // using printf() is a misery with this as C++ va_arg ellipsis changes float to double. +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wreserved-id-macro" // warning: macro name is a reserved identifier +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wimplicit-int-float-conversion" // warning: implicit conversion from 'xxx' to 'float' may lose precision +#elif defined(__GNUC__) +#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wpragmas" // warning: unknown option after '#pragma GCC diagnostic' kind +#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wint-to-pointer-cast" // warning: cast to pointer from integer of different size +#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wformat-security" // warning: format string is not a string literal (potentially insecure) +#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wdouble-promotion" // warning: implicit conversion from 'float' to 'double' when passing argument to function +#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wconversion" // warning: conversion to 'xxxx' from 'xxxx' may alter its value +#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wmisleading-indentation" // [__GNUC__ >= 6] warning: this 'if' clause does not guard this statement // GCC 6.0+ only. See #883 on GitHub. +#endif + +// Play it nice with Windows users (Update: May 2018, Notepad now supports Unix-style carriage returns!) +#ifdef _WIN32 +#define IM_NEWLINE "\r\n" +#else +#define IM_NEWLINE "\n" +#endif + +// Helpers +#if defined(_MSC_VER) && !defined(snprintf) +#define snprintf _snprintf +#endif +#if defined(_MSC_VER) && !defined(vsnprintf) +#define vsnprintf _vsnprintf +#endif + +// Format specifiers, printing 64-bit hasn't been decently standardized... +// In a real application you should be using PRId64 and PRIu64 from (non-windows) and on Windows define them yourself. +#ifdef _MSC_VER +#define IM_PRId64 "I64d" +#define IM_PRIu64 "I64u" +#else +#define IM_PRId64 "lld" +#define IM_PRIu64 "llu" +#endif + +// Helpers macros +// We normally try to not use many helpers in imgui_demo.cpp in order to make code easier to copy and paste, +// but making an exception here as those are largely simplifying code... +// In other imgui sources we can use nicer internal functions from imgui_internal.h (ImMin/ImMax) but not in the demo. +#define IM_MIN(A, B) (((A) < (B)) ? (A) : (B)) +#define IM_MAX(A, B) (((A) >= (B)) ? (A) : (B)) +#define IM_CLAMP(V, MN, MX) ((V) < (MN) ? (MN) : (V) > (MX) ? (MX) : (V)) + +// Enforce cdecl calling convention for functions called by the standard library, in case compilation settings changed the default to e.g. __vectorcall +#ifndef IMGUI_CDECL +#ifdef _MSC_VER +#define IMGUI_CDECL __cdecl +#else +#define IMGUI_CDECL +#endif +#endif + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Forward Declarations, Helpers +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +#if !defined(IMGUI_DISABLE_DEMO_WINDOWS) + +// Forward Declarations +static void ShowExampleAppDocuments(bool* p_open); +static void ShowExampleAppMainMenuBar(); +static void ShowExampleAppConsole(bool* p_open); +static void ShowExampleAppLog(bool* p_open); +static void ShowExampleAppLayout(bool* p_open); +static void ShowExampleAppPropertyEditor(bool* p_open); +static void ShowExampleAppLongText(bool* p_open); +static void ShowExampleAppAutoResize(bool* p_open); +static void ShowExampleAppConstrainedResize(bool* p_open); +static void ShowExampleAppSimpleOverlay(bool* p_open); +static void ShowExampleAppFullscreen(bool* p_open); +static void ShowExampleAppWindowTitles(bool* p_open); +static void ShowExampleAppCustomRendering(bool* p_open); +static void ShowExampleMenuFile(); + +// Helper to display a little (?) mark which shows a tooltip when hovered. +// In your own code you may want to display an actual icon if you are using a merged icon fonts (see docs/FONTS.md) +static void HelpMarker(const char* desc) +{ + ImGui::TextDisabled("(?)"); + if (ImGui::IsItemHovered()) + { + ImGui::BeginTooltip(); + ImGui::PushTextWrapPos(ImGui::GetFontSize() * 35.0f); + ImGui::TextUnformatted(desc); + ImGui::PopTextWrapPos(); + ImGui::EndTooltip(); + } +} + +// Helper to display basic user controls. +void ImGui::ShowUserGuide() +{ + ImGuiIO& io = ImGui::GetIO(); + ImGui::BulletText("Double-click on title bar to collapse window."); + ImGui::BulletText( + "Click and drag on lower corner to resize window\n" + "(double-click to auto fit window to its contents)."); + ImGui::BulletText("CTRL+Click on a slider or drag box to input value as text."); + ImGui::BulletText("TAB/SHIFT+TAB to cycle through keyboard editable fields."); + if (io.FontAllowUserScaling) + ImGui::BulletText("CTRL+Mouse Wheel to zoom window contents."); + ImGui::BulletText("While inputing text:\n"); + ImGui::Indent(); + ImGui::BulletText("CTRL+Left/Right to word jump."); + ImGui::BulletText("CTRL+A or double-click to select all."); + ImGui::BulletText("CTRL+X/C/V to use clipboard cut/copy/paste."); + ImGui::BulletText("CTRL+Z,CTRL+Y to undo/redo."); + ImGui::BulletText("ESCAPE to revert."); + ImGui::BulletText("You can apply arithmetic operators +,*,/ on numerical values.\nUse +- to subtract."); + ImGui::Unindent(); + ImGui::BulletText("With keyboard navigation enabled:"); + ImGui::Indent(); + ImGui::BulletText("Arrow keys to navigate."); + ImGui::BulletText("Space to activate a widget."); + ImGui::BulletText("Return to input text into a widget."); + ImGui::BulletText("Escape to deactivate a widget, close popup, exit child window."); + ImGui::BulletText("Alt to jump to the menu layer of a window."); + ImGui::BulletText("CTRL+Tab to select a window."); + ImGui::Unindent(); +} + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Demo Window / ShowDemoWindow() +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// - ShowDemoWindowWidgets() +// - ShowDemoWindowLayout() +// - ShowDemoWindowPopups() +// - ShowDemoWindowTables() +// - ShowDemoWindowColumns() +// - ShowDemoWindowMisc() +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// We split the contents of the big ShowDemoWindow() function into smaller functions +// (because the link time of very large functions grow non-linearly) +static void ShowDemoWindowWidgets(); +static void ShowDemoWindowLayout(); +static void ShowDemoWindowPopups(); +static void ShowDemoWindowTables(); +static void ShowDemoWindowColumns(); +static void ShowDemoWindowMisc(); + +// Demonstrate most Dear ImGui features (this is big function!) +// You may execute this function to experiment with the UI and understand what it does. +// You may then search for keywords in the code when you are interested by a specific feature. +void ImGui::ShowDemoWindow(bool* p_open) +{ + // Exceptionally add an extra assert here for people confused about initial Dear ImGui setup + // Most ImGui functions would normally just crash if the context is missing. + IM_ASSERT(ImGui::GetCurrentContext() != NULL && "Missing dear imgui context. Refer to examples app!"); + + // Examples Apps (accessible from the "Examples" menu) + static bool show_app_main_menu_bar = false; + static bool show_app_documents = false; + + static bool show_app_console = false; + static bool show_app_log = false; + static bool show_app_layout = false; + static bool show_app_property_editor = false; + static bool show_app_long_text = false; + static bool show_app_auto_resize = false; + static bool show_app_constrained_resize = false; + static bool show_app_simple_overlay = false; + static bool show_app_fullscreen = false; + static bool show_app_window_titles = false; + static bool show_app_custom_rendering = false; + + if (show_app_main_menu_bar) ShowExampleAppMainMenuBar(); + if (show_app_documents) ShowExampleAppDocuments(&show_app_documents); + + if (show_app_console) ShowExampleAppConsole(&show_app_console); + if (show_app_log) ShowExampleAppLog(&show_app_log); + if (show_app_layout) ShowExampleAppLayout(&show_app_layout); + if (show_app_property_editor) ShowExampleAppPropertyEditor(&show_app_property_editor); + if (show_app_long_text) ShowExampleAppLongText(&show_app_long_text); + if (show_app_auto_resize) ShowExampleAppAutoResize(&show_app_auto_resize); + if (show_app_constrained_resize) ShowExampleAppConstrainedResize(&show_app_constrained_resize); + if (show_app_simple_overlay) ShowExampleAppSimpleOverlay(&show_app_simple_overlay); + if (show_app_fullscreen) ShowExampleAppFullscreen(&show_app_fullscreen); + if (show_app_window_titles) ShowExampleAppWindowTitles(&show_app_window_titles); + if (show_app_custom_rendering) ShowExampleAppCustomRendering(&show_app_custom_rendering); + + // Dear ImGui Apps (accessible from the "Tools" menu) + static bool show_app_metrics = false; + static bool show_app_style_editor = false; + static bool show_app_about = false; + + if (show_app_metrics) { ImGui::ShowMetricsWindow(&show_app_metrics); } + if (show_app_about) { ImGui::ShowAboutWindow(&show_app_about); } + if (show_app_style_editor) + { + ImGui::Begin("Dear ImGui Style Editor", &show_app_style_editor); + ImGui::ShowStyleEditor(); + ImGui::End(); + } + + // Demonstrate the various window flags. Typically you would just use the default! + static bool no_titlebar = false; + static bool no_scrollbar = false; + static bool no_menu = false; + static bool no_move = false; + static bool no_resize = false; + static bool no_collapse = false; + static bool no_close = false; + static bool no_nav = false; + static bool no_background = false; + static bool no_bring_to_front = false; + static bool unsaved_document = false; + + ImGuiWindowFlags window_flags = 0; + if (no_titlebar) window_flags |= ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar; + if (no_scrollbar) window_flags |= ImGuiWindowFlags_NoScrollbar; + if (!no_menu) window_flags |= ImGuiWindowFlags_MenuBar; + if (no_move) window_flags |= ImGuiWindowFlags_NoMove; + if (no_resize) window_flags |= ImGuiWindowFlags_NoResize; + if (no_collapse) window_flags |= ImGuiWindowFlags_NoCollapse; + if (no_nav) window_flags |= ImGuiWindowFlags_NoNav; + if (no_background) window_flags |= ImGuiWindowFlags_NoBackground; + if (no_bring_to_front) window_flags |= ImGuiWindowFlags_NoBringToFrontOnFocus; + if (unsaved_document) window_flags |= ImGuiWindowFlags_UnsavedDocument; + if (no_close) p_open = NULL; // Don't pass our bool* to Begin + + // We specify a default position/size in case there's no data in the .ini file. + // We only do it to make the demo applications a little more welcoming, but typically this isn't required. + const ImGuiViewport* main_viewport = ImGui::GetMainViewport(); + ImGui::SetNextWindowPos(ImVec2(main_viewport->WorkPos.x + 650, main_viewport->WorkPos.y + 20), ImGuiCond_FirstUseEver); + ImGui::SetNextWindowSize(ImVec2(550, 680), ImGuiCond_FirstUseEver); + + // Main body of the Demo window starts here. + if (!ImGui::Begin("Dear ImGui Demo", p_open, window_flags)) + { + // Early out if the window is collapsed, as an optimization. + ImGui::End(); + return; + } + + // Most "big" widgets share a common width settings by default. See 'Demo->Layout->Widgets Width' for details. + + // e.g. Use 2/3 of the space for widgets and 1/3 for labels (right align) + //ImGui::PushItemWidth(-ImGui::GetWindowWidth() * 0.35f); + + // e.g. Leave a fixed amount of width for labels (by passing a negative value), the rest goes to widgets. + ImGui::PushItemWidth(ImGui::GetFontSize() * -12); + + // Menu Bar + if (ImGui::BeginMenuBar()) + { + if (ImGui::BeginMenu("Menu")) + { + ShowExampleMenuFile(); + ImGui::EndMenu(); + } + if (ImGui::BeginMenu("Examples")) + { + ImGui::MenuItem("Main menu bar", NULL, &show_app_main_menu_bar); + ImGui::MenuItem("Console", NULL, &show_app_console); + ImGui::MenuItem("Log", NULL, &show_app_log); + ImGui::MenuItem("Simple layout", NULL, &show_app_layout); + ImGui::MenuItem("Property editor", NULL, &show_app_property_editor); + ImGui::MenuItem("Long text display", NULL, &show_app_long_text); + ImGui::MenuItem("Auto-resizing window", NULL, &show_app_auto_resize); + ImGui::MenuItem("Constrained-resizing window", NULL, &show_app_constrained_resize); + ImGui::MenuItem("Simple overlay", NULL, &show_app_simple_overlay); + ImGui::MenuItem("Fullscreen window", NULL, &show_app_fullscreen); + ImGui::MenuItem("Manipulating window titles", NULL, &show_app_window_titles); + ImGui::MenuItem("Custom rendering", NULL, &show_app_custom_rendering); + ImGui::MenuItem("Documents", NULL, &show_app_documents); + ImGui::EndMenu(); + } + if (ImGui::BeginMenu("Tools")) + { + ImGui::MenuItem("Metrics/Debugger", NULL, &show_app_metrics); + ImGui::MenuItem("Style Editor", NULL, &show_app_style_editor); + ImGui::MenuItem("About Dear ImGui", NULL, &show_app_about); + ImGui::EndMenu(); + } + ImGui::EndMenuBar(); + } + + ImGui::Text("dear imgui says hello. (%s)", IMGUI_VERSION); + ImGui::Spacing(); + + if (ImGui::CollapsingHeader("Help")) + { + ImGui::Text("ABOUT THIS DEMO:"); + ImGui::BulletText("Sections below are demonstrating many aspects of the library."); + ImGui::BulletText("The \"Examples\" menu above leads to more demo contents."); + ImGui::BulletText("The \"Tools\" menu above gives access to: About Box, Style Editor,\n" + "and Metrics/Debugger (general purpose Dear ImGui debugging tool)."); + ImGui::Separator(); + + ImGui::Text("PROGRAMMER GUIDE:"); + ImGui::BulletText("See the ShowDemoWindow() code in imgui_demo.cpp. <- you are here!"); + ImGui::BulletText("See comments in imgui.cpp."); + ImGui::BulletText("See example applications in the examples/ folder."); + ImGui::BulletText("Read the FAQ at http://www.dearimgui.org/faq/"); + ImGui::BulletText("Set 'io.ConfigFlags |= NavEnableKeyboard' for keyboard controls."); + ImGui::BulletText("Set 'io.ConfigFlags |= NavEnableGamepad' for gamepad controls."); + ImGui::Separator(); + + ImGui::Text("USER GUIDE:"); + ImGui::ShowUserGuide(); + } + + if (ImGui::CollapsingHeader("Configuration")) + { + ImGuiIO& io = ImGui::GetIO(); + + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Configuration##2")) + { + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("io.ConfigFlags: NavEnableKeyboard", &io.ConfigFlags, ImGuiConfigFlags_NavEnableKeyboard); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Enable keyboard controls."); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("io.ConfigFlags: NavEnableGamepad", &io.ConfigFlags, ImGuiConfigFlags_NavEnableGamepad); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Enable gamepad controls. Require backend to set io.BackendFlags |= ImGuiBackendFlags_HasGamepad.\n\nRead instructions in imgui.cpp for details."); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("io.ConfigFlags: NavEnableSetMousePos", &io.ConfigFlags, ImGuiConfigFlags_NavEnableSetMousePos); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Instruct navigation to move the mouse cursor. See comment for ImGuiConfigFlags_NavEnableSetMousePos."); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("io.ConfigFlags: NoMouse", &io.ConfigFlags, ImGuiConfigFlags_NoMouse); + if (io.ConfigFlags & ImGuiConfigFlags_NoMouse) + { + // The "NoMouse" option can get us stuck with a disabled mouse! Let's provide an alternative way to fix it: + if (fmodf((float)ImGui::GetTime(), 0.40f) < 0.20f) + { + ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::Text("<>"); + } + if (ImGui::IsKeyPressed(ImGui::GetKeyIndex(ImGuiKey_Space))) + io.ConfigFlags &= ~ImGuiConfigFlags_NoMouse; + } + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("io.ConfigFlags: NoMouseCursorChange", &io.ConfigFlags, ImGuiConfigFlags_NoMouseCursorChange); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Instruct backend to not alter mouse cursor shape and visibility."); + ImGui::Checkbox("io.ConfigInputTextCursorBlink", &io.ConfigInputTextCursorBlink); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Enable blinking cursor (optional as some users consider it to be distracting)"); + ImGui::Checkbox("io.ConfigDragClickToInputText", &io.ConfigDragClickToInputText); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Enable turning DragXXX widgets into text input with a simple mouse click-release (without moving)."); + ImGui::Checkbox("io.ConfigWindowsResizeFromEdges", &io.ConfigWindowsResizeFromEdges); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Enable resizing of windows from their edges and from the lower-left corner.\nThis requires (io.BackendFlags & ImGuiBackendFlags_HasMouseCursors) because it needs mouse cursor feedback."); + ImGui::Checkbox("io.ConfigWindowsMoveFromTitleBarOnly", &io.ConfigWindowsMoveFromTitleBarOnly); + ImGui::Checkbox("io.MouseDrawCursor", &io.MouseDrawCursor); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Instruct Dear ImGui to render a mouse cursor itself. Note that a mouse cursor rendered via your application GPU rendering path will feel more laggy than hardware cursor, but will be more in sync with your other visuals.\n\nSome desktop applications may use both kinds of cursors (e.g. enable software cursor only when resizing/dragging something)."); + ImGui::Text("Also see Style->Rendering for rendering options."); + ImGui::TreePop(); + ImGui::Separator(); + } + + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Backend Flags")) + { + HelpMarker( + "Those flags are set by the backends (imgui_impl_xxx files) to specify their capabilities.\n" + "Here we expose them as read-only fields to avoid breaking interactions with your backend."); + + // Make a local copy to avoid modifying actual backend flags. + ImGuiBackendFlags backend_flags = io.BackendFlags; + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("io.BackendFlags: HasGamepad", &backend_flags, ImGuiBackendFlags_HasGamepad); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("io.BackendFlags: HasMouseCursors", &backend_flags, ImGuiBackendFlags_HasMouseCursors); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("io.BackendFlags: HasSetMousePos", &backend_flags, ImGuiBackendFlags_HasSetMousePos); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("io.BackendFlags: RendererHasVtxOffset", &backend_flags, ImGuiBackendFlags_RendererHasVtxOffset); + ImGui::TreePop(); + ImGui::Separator(); + } + + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Style")) + { + HelpMarker("The same contents can be accessed in 'Tools->Style Editor' or by calling the ShowStyleEditor() function."); + ImGui::ShowStyleEditor(); + ImGui::TreePop(); + ImGui::Separator(); + } + + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Capture/Logging")) + { + HelpMarker( + "The logging API redirects all text output so you can easily capture the content of " + "a window or a block. Tree nodes can be automatically expanded.\n" + "Try opening any of the contents below in this window and then click one of the \"Log To\" button."); + ImGui::LogButtons(); + + HelpMarker("You can also call ImGui::LogText() to output directly to the log without a visual output."); + if (ImGui::Button("Copy \"Hello, world!\" to clipboard")) + { + ImGui::LogToClipboard(); + ImGui::LogText("Hello, world!"); + ImGui::LogFinish(); + } + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + } + + if (ImGui::CollapsingHeader("Window options")) + { + if (ImGui::BeginTable("split", 3)) + { + ImGui::TableNextColumn(); ImGui::Checkbox("No titlebar", &no_titlebar); + ImGui::TableNextColumn(); ImGui::Checkbox("No scrollbar", &no_scrollbar); + ImGui::TableNextColumn(); ImGui::Checkbox("No menu", &no_menu); + ImGui::TableNextColumn(); ImGui::Checkbox("No move", &no_move); + ImGui::TableNextColumn(); ImGui::Checkbox("No resize", &no_resize); + ImGui::TableNextColumn(); ImGui::Checkbox("No collapse", &no_collapse); + ImGui::TableNextColumn(); ImGui::Checkbox("No close", &no_close); + ImGui::TableNextColumn(); ImGui::Checkbox("No nav", &no_nav); + ImGui::TableNextColumn(); ImGui::Checkbox("No background", &no_background); + ImGui::TableNextColumn(); ImGui::Checkbox("No bring to front", &no_bring_to_front); + ImGui::TableNextColumn(); ImGui::Checkbox("Unsaved document", &unsaved_document); + ImGui::EndTable(); + } + } + + // All demo contents + ShowDemoWindowWidgets(); + ShowDemoWindowLayout(); + ShowDemoWindowPopups(); + ShowDemoWindowTables(); + ShowDemoWindowMisc(); + + // End of ShowDemoWindow() + ImGui::PopItemWidth(); + ImGui::End(); +} + +static void ShowDemoWindowWidgets() +{ + if (!ImGui::CollapsingHeader("Widgets")) + return; + + static bool disable_all = false; // The Checkbox for that is inside the "Disabled" section at the bottom + if (disable_all) + ImGui::BeginDisabled(); + + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Basic")) + { + static int clicked = 0; + if (ImGui::Button("Button")) + clicked++; + if (clicked & 1) + { + ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::Text("Thanks for clicking me!"); + } + + static bool check = true; + ImGui::Checkbox("checkbox", &check); + + static int e = 0; + ImGui::RadioButton("radio a", &e, 0); ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::RadioButton("radio b", &e, 1); ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::RadioButton("radio c", &e, 2); + + // Color buttons, demonstrate using PushID() to add unique identifier in the ID stack, and changing style. + for (int i = 0; i < 7; i++) + { + if (i > 0) + ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::PushID(i); + ImGui::PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_Button, (ImVec4)ImColor::HSV(i / 7.0f, 0.6f, 0.6f)); + ImGui::PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_ButtonHovered, (ImVec4)ImColor::HSV(i / 7.0f, 0.7f, 0.7f)); + ImGui::PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_ButtonActive, (ImVec4)ImColor::HSV(i / 7.0f, 0.8f, 0.8f)); + ImGui::Button("Click"); + ImGui::PopStyleColor(3); + ImGui::PopID(); + } + + // Use AlignTextToFramePadding() to align text baseline to the baseline of framed widgets elements + // (otherwise a Text+SameLine+Button sequence will have the text a little too high by default!) + // See 'Demo->Layout->Text Baseline Alignment' for details. + ImGui::AlignTextToFramePadding(); + ImGui::Text("Hold to repeat:"); + ImGui::SameLine(); + + // Arrow buttons with Repeater + static int counter = 0; + float spacing = ImGui::GetStyle().ItemInnerSpacing.x; + ImGui::PushButtonRepeat(true); + if (ImGui::ArrowButton("##left", ImGuiDir_Left)) { counter--; } + ImGui::SameLine(0.0f, spacing); + if (ImGui::ArrowButton("##right", ImGuiDir_Right)) { counter++; } + ImGui::PopButtonRepeat(); + ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::Text("%d", counter); + + ImGui::Text("Hover over me"); + if (ImGui::IsItemHovered()) + ImGui::SetTooltip("I am a tooltip"); + + ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::Text("- or me"); + if (ImGui::IsItemHovered()) + { + ImGui::BeginTooltip(); + ImGui::Text("I am a fancy tooltip"); + static float arr[] = { 0.6f, 0.1f, 1.0f, 0.5f, 0.92f, 0.1f, 0.2f }; + ImGui::PlotLines("Curve", arr, IM_ARRAYSIZE(arr)); + ImGui::EndTooltip(); + } + + ImGui::Separator(); + + ImGui::LabelText("label", "Value"); + + { + // Using the _simplified_ one-liner Combo() api here + // See "Combo" section for examples of how to use the more flexible BeginCombo()/EndCombo() api. + const char* items[] = { "AAAA", "BBBB", "CCCC", "DDDD", "EEEE", "FFFF", "GGGG", "HHHH", "IIIIIII", "JJJJ", "KKKKKKK" }; + static int item_current = 0; + ImGui::Combo("combo", &item_current, items, IM_ARRAYSIZE(items)); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker( + "Using the simplified one-liner Combo API here.\nRefer to the \"Combo\" section below for an explanation of how to use the more flexible and general BeginCombo/EndCombo API."); + } + + { + // To wire InputText() with std::string or any other custom string type, + // see the "Text Input > Resize Callback" section of this demo, and the misc/cpp/imgui_stdlib.h file. + static char str0[128] = "Hello, world!"; + ImGui::InputText("input text", str0, IM_ARRAYSIZE(str0)); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker( + "USER:\n" + "Hold SHIFT or use mouse to select text.\n" + "CTRL+Left/Right to word jump.\n" + "CTRL+A or double-click to select all.\n" + "CTRL+X,CTRL+C,CTRL+V clipboard.\n" + "CTRL+Z,CTRL+Y undo/redo.\n" + "ESCAPE to revert.\n\n" + "PROGRAMMER:\n" + "You can use the ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackResize facility if you need to wire InputText() " + "to a dynamic string type. See misc/cpp/imgui_stdlib.h for an example (this is not demonstrated " + "in imgui_demo.cpp)."); + + static char str1[128] = ""; + ImGui::InputTextWithHint("input text (w/ hint)", "enter text here", str1, IM_ARRAYSIZE(str1)); + + static int i0 = 123; + ImGui::InputInt("input int", &i0); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker( + "You can apply arithmetic operators +,*,/ on numerical values.\n" + " e.g. [ 100 ], input \'*2\', result becomes [ 200 ]\n" + "Use +- to subtract."); + + static float f0 = 0.001f; + ImGui::InputFloat("input float", &f0, 0.01f, 1.0f, "%.3f"); + + static double d0 = 999999.00000001; + ImGui::InputDouble("input double", &d0, 0.01f, 1.0f, "%.8f"); + + static float f1 = 1.e10f; + ImGui::InputFloat("input scientific", &f1, 0.0f, 0.0f, "%e"); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker( + "You can input value using the scientific notation,\n" + " e.g. \"1e+8\" becomes \"100000000\"."); + + static float vec4a[4] = { 0.10f, 0.20f, 0.30f, 0.44f }; + ImGui::InputFloat3("input float3", vec4a); + } + + { + static int i1 = 50, i2 = 42; + ImGui::DragInt("drag int", &i1, 1); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker( + "Click and drag to edit value.\n" + "Hold SHIFT/ALT for faster/slower edit.\n" + "Double-click or CTRL+click to input value."); + + ImGui::DragInt("drag int 0..100", &i2, 1, 0, 100, "%d%%", ImGuiSliderFlags_AlwaysClamp); + + static float f1 = 1.00f, f2 = 0.0067f; + ImGui::DragFloat("drag float", &f1, 0.005f); + ImGui::DragFloat("drag small float", &f2, 0.0001f, 0.0f, 0.0f, "%.06f ns"); + } + + { + static int i1 = 0; + ImGui::SliderInt("slider int", &i1, -1, 3); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("CTRL+click to input value."); + + static float f1 = 0.123f, f2 = 0.0f; + ImGui::SliderFloat("slider float", &f1, 0.0f, 1.0f, "ratio = %.3f"); + ImGui::SliderFloat("slider float (log)", &f2, -10.0f, 10.0f, "%.4f", ImGuiSliderFlags_Logarithmic); + + static float angle = 0.0f; + ImGui::SliderAngle("slider angle", &angle); + + // Using the format string to display a name instead of an integer. + // Here we completely omit '%d' from the format string, so it'll only display a name. + // This technique can also be used with DragInt(). + enum Element { Element_Fire, Element_Earth, Element_Air, Element_Water, Element_COUNT }; + static int elem = Element_Fire; + const char* elems_names[Element_COUNT] = { "Fire", "Earth", "Air", "Water" }; + const char* elem_name = (elem >= 0 && elem < Element_COUNT) ? elems_names[elem] : "Unknown"; + ImGui::SliderInt("slider enum", &elem, 0, Element_COUNT - 1, elem_name); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Using the format string parameter to display a name instead of the underlying integer."); + } + + { + static float col1[3] = { 1.0f, 0.0f, 0.2f }; + static float col2[4] = { 0.4f, 0.7f, 0.0f, 0.5f }; + ImGui::ColorEdit3("color 1", col1); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker( + "Click on the color square to open a color picker.\n" + "Click and hold to use drag and drop.\n" + "Right-click on the color square to show options.\n" + "CTRL+click on individual component to input value.\n"); + + ImGui::ColorEdit4("color 2", col2); + } + + { + // Using the _simplified_ one-liner ListBox() api here + // See "List boxes" section for examples of how to use the more flexible BeginListBox()/EndListBox() api. + const char* items[] = { "Apple", "Banana", "Cherry", "Kiwi", "Mango", "Orange", "Pineapple", "Strawberry", "Watermelon" }; + static int item_current = 1; + ImGui::ListBox("listbox", &item_current, items, IM_ARRAYSIZE(items), 4); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker( + "Using the simplified one-liner ListBox API here.\nRefer to the \"List boxes\" section below for an explanation of how to use the more flexible and general BeginListBox/EndListBox API."); + } + + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + // Testing ImGuiOnceUponAFrame helper. + //static ImGuiOnceUponAFrame once; + //for (int i = 0; i < 5; i++) + // if (once) + // ImGui::Text("This will be displayed only once."); + + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Trees")) + { + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Basic trees")) + { + for (int i = 0; i < 5; i++) + { + // Use SetNextItemOpen() so set the default state of a node to be open. We could + // also use TreeNodeEx() with the ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_DefaultOpen flag to achieve the same thing! + if (i == 0) + ImGui::SetNextItemOpen(true, ImGuiCond_Once); + + if (ImGui::TreeNode((void*)(intptr_t)i, "Child %d", i)) + { + ImGui::Text("blah blah"); + ImGui::SameLine(); + if (ImGui::SmallButton("button")) {} + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + } + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Advanced, with Selectable nodes")) + { + HelpMarker( + "This is a more typical looking tree with selectable nodes.\n" + "Click to select, CTRL+Click to toggle, click on arrows or double-click to open."); + static ImGuiTreeNodeFlags base_flags = ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_OpenOnArrow | ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_OpenOnDoubleClick | ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_SpanAvailWidth; + static bool align_label_with_current_x_position = false; + static bool test_drag_and_drop = false; + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_OpenOnArrow", &base_flags, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_OpenOnArrow); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_OpenOnDoubleClick", &base_flags, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_OpenOnDoubleClick); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_SpanAvailWidth", &base_flags, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_SpanAvailWidth); ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Extend hit area to all available width instead of allowing more items to be laid out after the node."); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_SpanFullWidth", &base_flags, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_SpanFullWidth); + ImGui::Checkbox("Align label with current X position", &align_label_with_current_x_position); + ImGui::Checkbox("Test tree node as drag source", &test_drag_and_drop); + ImGui::Text("Hello!"); + if (align_label_with_current_x_position) + ImGui::Unindent(ImGui::GetTreeNodeToLabelSpacing()); + + // 'selection_mask' is dumb representation of what may be user-side selection state. + // You may retain selection state inside or outside your objects in whatever format you see fit. + // 'node_clicked' is temporary storage of what node we have clicked to process selection at the end + /// of the loop. May be a pointer to your own node type, etc. + static int selection_mask = (1 << 2); + int node_clicked = -1; + for (int i = 0; i < 6; i++) + { + // Disable the default "open on single-click behavior" + set Selected flag according to our selection. + ImGuiTreeNodeFlags node_flags = base_flags; + const bool is_selected = (selection_mask & (1 << i)) != 0; + if (is_selected) + node_flags |= ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Selected; + if (i < 3) + { + // Items 0..2 are Tree Node + bool node_open = ImGui::TreeNodeEx((void*)(intptr_t)i, node_flags, "Selectable Node %d", i); + if (ImGui::IsItemClicked()) + node_clicked = i; + if (test_drag_and_drop && ImGui::BeginDragDropSource()) + { + ImGui::SetDragDropPayload("_TREENODE", NULL, 0); + ImGui::Text("This is a drag and drop source"); + ImGui::EndDragDropSource(); + } + if (node_open) + { + ImGui::BulletText("Blah blah\nBlah Blah"); + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + } + else + { + // Items 3..5 are Tree Leaves + // The only reason we use TreeNode at all is to allow selection of the leaf. Otherwise we can + // use BulletText() or advance the cursor by GetTreeNodeToLabelSpacing() and call Text(). + node_flags |= ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Leaf | ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NoTreePushOnOpen; // ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Bullet + ImGui::TreeNodeEx((void*)(intptr_t)i, node_flags, "Selectable Leaf %d", i); + if (ImGui::IsItemClicked()) + node_clicked = i; + if (test_drag_and_drop && ImGui::BeginDragDropSource()) + { + ImGui::SetDragDropPayload("_TREENODE", NULL, 0); + ImGui::Text("This is a drag and drop source"); + ImGui::EndDragDropSource(); + } + } + } + if (node_clicked != -1) + { + // Update selection state + // (process outside of tree loop to avoid visual inconsistencies during the clicking frame) + if (ImGui::GetIO().KeyCtrl) + selection_mask ^= (1 << node_clicked); // CTRL+click to toggle + else //if (!(selection_mask & (1 << node_clicked))) // Depending on selection behavior you want, may want to preserve selection when clicking on item that is part of the selection + selection_mask = (1 << node_clicked); // Click to single-select + } + if (align_label_with_current_x_position) + ImGui::Indent(ImGui::GetTreeNodeToLabelSpacing()); + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Collapsing Headers")) + { + static bool closable_group = true; + ImGui::Checkbox("Show 2nd header", &closable_group); + if (ImGui::CollapsingHeader("Header", ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_None)) + { + ImGui::Text("IsItemHovered: %d", ImGui::IsItemHovered()); + for (int i = 0; i < 5; i++) + ImGui::Text("Some content %d", i); + } + if (ImGui::CollapsingHeader("Header with a close button", &closable_group)) + { + ImGui::Text("IsItemHovered: %d", ImGui::IsItemHovered()); + for (int i = 0; i < 5; i++) + ImGui::Text("More content %d", i); + } + /* + if (ImGui::CollapsingHeader("Header with a bullet", ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Bullet)) + ImGui::Text("IsItemHovered: %d", ImGui::IsItemHovered()); + */ + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Bullets")) + { + ImGui::BulletText("Bullet point 1"); + ImGui::BulletText("Bullet point 2\nOn multiple lines"); + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Tree node")) + { + ImGui::BulletText("Another bullet point"); + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + ImGui::Bullet(); ImGui::Text("Bullet point 3 (two calls)"); + ImGui::Bullet(); ImGui::SmallButton("Button"); + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Text")) + { + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Colorful Text")) + { + // Using shortcut. You can use PushStyleColor()/PopStyleColor() for more flexibility. + ImGui::TextColored(ImVec4(1.0f, 0.0f, 1.0f, 1.0f), "Pink"); + ImGui::TextColored(ImVec4(1.0f, 1.0f, 0.0f, 1.0f), "Yellow"); + ImGui::TextDisabled("Disabled"); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("The TextDisabled color is stored in ImGuiStyle."); + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Word Wrapping")) + { + // Using shortcut. You can use PushTextWrapPos()/PopTextWrapPos() for more flexibility. + ImGui::TextWrapped( + "This text should automatically wrap on the edge of the window. The current implementation " + "for text wrapping follows simple rules suitable for English and possibly other languages."); + ImGui::Spacing(); + + static float wrap_width = 200.0f; + ImGui::SliderFloat("Wrap width", &wrap_width, -20, 600, "%.0f"); + + ImDrawList* draw_list = ImGui::GetWindowDrawList(); + for (int n = 0; n < 2; n++) + { + ImGui::Text("Test paragraph %d:", n); + ImVec2 pos = ImGui::GetCursorScreenPos(); + ImVec2 marker_min = ImVec2(pos.x + wrap_width, pos.y); + ImVec2 marker_max = ImVec2(pos.x + wrap_width + 10, pos.y + ImGui::GetTextLineHeight()); + ImGui::PushTextWrapPos(ImGui::GetCursorPos().x + wrap_width); + if (n == 0) + ImGui::Text("The lazy dog is a good dog. This paragraph should fit within %.0f pixels. Testing a 1 character word. The quick brown fox jumps over the lazy dog.", wrap_width); + else + ImGui::Text("aaaaaaaa bbbbbbbb, c cccccccc,dddddddd. d eeeeeeee ffffffff. gggggggg!hhhhhhhh"); + + // Draw actual text bounding box, following by marker of our expected limit (should not overlap!) + draw_list->AddRect(ImGui::GetItemRectMin(), ImGui::GetItemRectMax(), IM_COL32(255, 255, 0, 255)); + draw_list->AddRectFilled(marker_min, marker_max, IM_COL32(255, 0, 255, 255)); + ImGui::PopTextWrapPos(); + } + + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (ImGui::TreeNode("UTF-8 Text")) + { + // UTF-8 test with Japanese characters + // (Needs a suitable font? Try "Google Noto" or "Arial Unicode". See docs/FONTS.md for details.) + // - From C++11 you can use the u8"my text" syntax to encode literal strings as UTF-8 + // - For earlier compiler, you may be able to encode your sources as UTF-8 (e.g. in Visual Studio, you + // can save your source files as 'UTF-8 without signature'). + // - FOR THIS DEMO FILE ONLY, BECAUSE WE WANT TO SUPPORT OLD COMPILERS, WE ARE *NOT* INCLUDING RAW UTF-8 + // CHARACTERS IN THIS SOURCE FILE. Instead we are encoding a few strings with hexadecimal constants. + // Don't do this in your application! Please use u8"text in any language" in your application! + // Note that characters values are preserved even by InputText() if the font cannot be displayed, + // so you can safely copy & paste garbled characters into another application. + ImGui::TextWrapped( + "CJK text will only appears if the font was loaded with the appropriate CJK character ranges. " + "Call io.Fonts->AddFontFromFileTTF() manually to load extra character ranges. " + "Read docs/FONTS.md for details."); + ImGui::Text("Hiragana: \xe3\x81\x8b\xe3\x81\x8d\xe3\x81\x8f\xe3\x81\x91\xe3\x81\x93 (kakikukeko)"); // Normally we would use u8"blah blah" with the proper characters directly in the string. + ImGui::Text("Kanjis: \xe6\x97\xa5\xe6\x9c\xac\xe8\xaa\x9e (nihongo)"); + static char buf[32] = "\xe6\x97\xa5\xe6\x9c\xac\xe8\xaa\x9e"; + //static char buf[32] = u8"NIHONGO"; // <- this is how you would write it with C++11, using real kanjis + ImGui::InputText("UTF-8 input", buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf)); + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Images")) + { + ImGuiIO& io = ImGui::GetIO(); + ImGui::TextWrapped( + "Below we are displaying the font texture (which is the only texture we have access to in this demo). " + "Use the 'ImTextureID' type as storage to pass pointers or identifier to your own texture data. " + "Hover the texture for a zoomed view!"); + + // Below we are displaying the font texture because it is the only texture we have access to inside the demo! + // Remember that ImTextureID is just storage for whatever you want it to be. It is essentially a value that + // will be passed to the rendering backend via the ImDrawCmd structure. + // If you use one of the default imgui_impl_XXXX.cpp rendering backend, they all have comments at the top + // of their respective source file to specify what they expect to be stored in ImTextureID, for example: + // - The imgui_impl_dx11.cpp renderer expect a 'ID3D11ShaderResourceView*' pointer + // - The imgui_impl_opengl3.cpp renderer expect a GLuint OpenGL texture identifier, etc. + // More: + // - If you decided that ImTextureID = MyEngineTexture*, then you can pass your MyEngineTexture* pointers + // to ImGui::Image(), and gather width/height through your own functions, etc. + // - You can use ShowMetricsWindow() to inspect the draw data that are being passed to your renderer, + // it will help you debug issues if you are confused about it. + // - Consider using the lower-level ImDrawList::AddImage() API, via ImGui::GetWindowDrawList()->AddImage(). + // - Read https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/blob/master/docs/FAQ.md + // - Read https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/wiki/Image-Loading-and-Displaying-Examples + ImTextureID my_tex_id = io.Fonts->TexID; + float my_tex_w = (float)io.Fonts->TexWidth; + float my_tex_h = (float)io.Fonts->TexHeight; + { + ImGui::Text("%.0fx%.0f", my_tex_w, my_tex_h); + ImVec2 pos = ImGui::GetCursorScreenPos(); + ImVec2 uv_min = ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f); // Top-left + ImVec2 uv_max = ImVec2(1.0f, 1.0f); // Lower-right + ImVec4 tint_col = ImVec4(1.0f, 1.0f, 1.0f, 1.0f); // No tint + ImVec4 border_col = ImVec4(1.0f, 1.0f, 1.0f, 0.5f); // 50% opaque white + ImGui::Image(my_tex_id, ImVec2(my_tex_w, my_tex_h), uv_min, uv_max, tint_col, border_col); + if (ImGui::IsItemHovered()) + { + ImGui::BeginTooltip(); + float region_sz = 32.0f; + float region_x = io.MousePos.x - pos.x - region_sz * 0.5f; + float region_y = io.MousePos.y - pos.y - region_sz * 0.5f; + float zoom = 4.0f; + if (region_x < 0.0f) { region_x = 0.0f; } + else if (region_x > my_tex_w - region_sz) { region_x = my_tex_w - region_sz; } + if (region_y < 0.0f) { region_y = 0.0f; } + else if (region_y > my_tex_h - region_sz) { region_y = my_tex_h - region_sz; } + ImGui::Text("Min: (%.2f, %.2f)", region_x, region_y); + ImGui::Text("Max: (%.2f, %.2f)", region_x + region_sz, region_y + region_sz); + ImVec2 uv0 = ImVec2((region_x) / my_tex_w, (region_y) / my_tex_h); + ImVec2 uv1 = ImVec2((region_x + region_sz) / my_tex_w, (region_y + region_sz) / my_tex_h); + ImGui::Image(my_tex_id, ImVec2(region_sz * zoom, region_sz * zoom), uv0, uv1, tint_col, border_col); + ImGui::EndTooltip(); + } + } + ImGui::TextWrapped("And now some textured buttons.."); + static int pressed_count = 0; + for (int i = 0; i < 8; i++) + { + ImGui::PushID(i); + int frame_padding = -1 + i; // -1 == uses default padding (style.FramePadding) + ImVec2 size = ImVec2(32.0f, 32.0f); // Size of the image we want to make visible + ImVec2 uv0 = ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f); // UV coordinates for lower-left + ImVec2 uv1 = ImVec2(32.0f / my_tex_w, 32.0f / my_tex_h);// UV coordinates for (32,32) in our texture + ImVec4 bg_col = ImVec4(0.0f, 0.0f, 0.0f, 1.0f); // Black background + ImVec4 tint_col = ImVec4(1.0f, 1.0f, 1.0f, 1.0f); // No tint + if (ImGui::ImageButton(my_tex_id, size, uv0, uv1, frame_padding, bg_col, tint_col)) + pressed_count += 1; + ImGui::PopID(); + ImGui::SameLine(); + } + ImGui::NewLine(); + ImGui::Text("Pressed %d times.", pressed_count); + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Combo")) + { + // Expose flags as checkbox for the demo + static ImGuiComboFlags flags = 0; + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiComboFlags_PopupAlignLeft", &flags, ImGuiComboFlags_PopupAlignLeft); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Only makes a difference if the popup is larger than the combo"); + if (ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiComboFlags_NoArrowButton", &flags, ImGuiComboFlags_NoArrowButton)) + flags &= ~ImGuiComboFlags_NoPreview; // Clear the other flag, as we cannot combine both + if (ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiComboFlags_NoPreview", &flags, ImGuiComboFlags_NoPreview)) + flags &= ~ImGuiComboFlags_NoArrowButton; // Clear the other flag, as we cannot combine both + + // Using the generic BeginCombo() API, you have full control over how to display the combo contents. + // (your selection data could be an index, a pointer to the object, an id for the object, a flag intrusively + // stored in the object itself, etc.) + const char* items[] = { "AAAA", "BBBB", "CCCC", "DDDD", "EEEE", "FFFF", "GGGG", "HHHH", "IIII", "JJJJ", "KKKK", "LLLLLLL", "MMMM", "OOOOOOO" }; + static int item_current_idx = 0; // Here we store our selection data as an index. + const char* combo_preview_value = items[item_current_idx]; // Pass in the preview value visible before opening the combo (it could be anything) + if (ImGui::BeginCombo("combo 1", combo_preview_value, flags)) + { + for (int n = 0; n < IM_ARRAYSIZE(items); n++) + { + const bool is_selected = (item_current_idx == n); + if (ImGui::Selectable(items[n], is_selected)) + item_current_idx = n; + + // Set the initial focus when opening the combo (scrolling + keyboard navigation focus) + if (is_selected) + ImGui::SetItemDefaultFocus(); + } + ImGui::EndCombo(); + } + + // Simplified one-liner Combo() API, using values packed in a single constant string + // This is a convenience for when the selection set is small and known at compile-time. + static int item_current_2 = 0; + ImGui::Combo("combo 2 (one-liner)", &item_current_2, "aaaa\0bbbb\0cccc\0dddd\0eeee\0\0"); + + // Simplified one-liner Combo() using an array of const char* + // This is not very useful (may obsolete): prefer using BeginCombo()/EndCombo() for full control. + static int item_current_3 = -1; // If the selection isn't within 0..count, Combo won't display a preview + ImGui::Combo("combo 3 (array)", &item_current_3, items, IM_ARRAYSIZE(items)); + + // Simplified one-liner Combo() using an accessor function + struct Funcs { static bool ItemGetter(void* data, int n, const char** out_str) { *out_str = ((const char**)data)[n]; return true; } }; + static int item_current_4 = 0; + ImGui::Combo("combo 4 (function)", &item_current_4, &Funcs::ItemGetter, items, IM_ARRAYSIZE(items)); + + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (ImGui::TreeNode("List boxes")) + { + // Using the generic BeginListBox() API, you have full control over how to display the combo contents. + // (your selection data could be an index, a pointer to the object, an id for the object, a flag intrusively + // stored in the object itself, etc.) + const char* items[] = { "AAAA", "BBBB", "CCCC", "DDDD", "EEEE", "FFFF", "GGGG", "HHHH", "IIII", "JJJJ", "KKKK", "LLLLLLL", "MMMM", "OOOOOOO" }; + static int item_current_idx = 0; // Here we store our selection data as an index. + if (ImGui::BeginListBox("listbox 1")) + { + for (int n = 0; n < IM_ARRAYSIZE(items); n++) + { + const bool is_selected = (item_current_idx == n); + if (ImGui::Selectable(items[n], is_selected)) + item_current_idx = n; + + // Set the initial focus when opening the combo (scrolling + keyboard navigation focus) + if (is_selected) + ImGui::SetItemDefaultFocus(); + } + ImGui::EndListBox(); + } + + // Custom size: use all width, 5 items tall + ImGui::Text("Full-width:"); + if (ImGui::BeginListBox("##listbox 2", ImVec2(-FLT_MIN, 5 * ImGui::GetTextLineHeightWithSpacing()))) + { + for (int n = 0; n < IM_ARRAYSIZE(items); n++) + { + const bool is_selected = (item_current_idx == n); + if (ImGui::Selectable(items[n], is_selected)) + item_current_idx = n; + + // Set the initial focus when opening the combo (scrolling + keyboard navigation focus) + if (is_selected) + ImGui::SetItemDefaultFocus(); + } + ImGui::EndListBox(); + } + + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Selectables")) + { + // Selectable() has 2 overloads: + // - The one taking "bool selected" as a read-only selection information. + // When Selectable() has been clicked it returns true and you can alter selection state accordingly. + // - The one taking "bool* p_selected" as a read-write selection information (convenient in some cases) + // The earlier is more flexible, as in real application your selection may be stored in many different ways + // and not necessarily inside a bool value (e.g. in flags within objects, as an external list, etc). + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Basic")) + { + static bool selection[5] = { false, true, false, false, false }; + ImGui::Selectable("1. I am selectable", &selection[0]); + ImGui::Selectable("2. I am selectable", &selection[1]); + ImGui::Text("(I am not selectable)"); + ImGui::Selectable("4. I am selectable", &selection[3]); + if (ImGui::Selectable("5. I am double clickable", selection[4], ImGuiSelectableFlags_AllowDoubleClick)) + if (ImGui::IsMouseDoubleClicked(0)) + selection[4] = !selection[4]; + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Selection State: Single Selection")) + { + static int selected = -1; + for (int n = 0; n < 5; n++) + { + char buf[32]; + sprintf(buf, "Object %d", n); + if (ImGui::Selectable(buf, selected == n)) + selected = n; + } + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Selection State: Multiple Selection")) + { + HelpMarker("Hold CTRL and click to select multiple items."); + static bool selection[5] = { false, false, false, false, false }; + for (int n = 0; n < 5; n++) + { + char buf[32]; + sprintf(buf, "Object %d", n); + if (ImGui::Selectable(buf, selection[n])) + { + if (!ImGui::GetIO().KeyCtrl) // Clear selection when CTRL is not held + memset(selection, 0, sizeof(selection)); + selection[n] ^= 1; + } + } + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Rendering more text into the same line")) + { + // Using the Selectable() override that takes "bool* p_selected" parameter, + // this function toggle your bool value automatically. + static bool selected[3] = { false, false, false }; + ImGui::Selectable("main.c", &selected[0]); ImGui::SameLine(300); ImGui::Text(" 2,345 bytes"); + ImGui::Selectable("Hello.cpp", &selected[1]); ImGui::SameLine(300); ImGui::Text("12,345 bytes"); + ImGui::Selectable("Hello.h", &selected[2]); ImGui::SameLine(300); ImGui::Text(" 2,345 bytes"); + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + if (ImGui::TreeNode("In columns")) + { + static bool selected[10] = {}; + + if (ImGui::BeginTable("split1", 3, ImGuiTableFlags_Resizable | ImGuiTableFlags_NoSavedSettings | ImGuiTableFlags_Borders)) + { + for (int i = 0; i < 10; i++) + { + char label[32]; + sprintf(label, "Item %d", i); + ImGui::TableNextColumn(); + ImGui::Selectable(label, &selected[i]); // FIXME-TABLE: Selection overlap + } + ImGui::EndTable(); + } + ImGui::Spacing(); + if (ImGui::BeginTable("split2", 3, ImGuiTableFlags_Resizable | ImGuiTableFlags_NoSavedSettings | ImGuiTableFlags_Borders)) + { + for (int i = 0; i < 10; i++) + { + char label[32]; + sprintf(label, "Item %d", i); + ImGui::TableNextRow(); + ImGui::TableNextColumn(); + ImGui::Selectable(label, &selected[i], ImGuiSelectableFlags_SpanAllColumns); + ImGui::TableNextColumn(); + ImGui::Text("Some other contents"); + ImGui::TableNextColumn(); + ImGui::Text("123456"); + } + ImGui::EndTable(); + } + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Grid")) + { + static char selected[4][4] = { { 1, 0, 0, 0 }, { 0, 1, 0, 0 }, { 0, 0, 1, 0 }, { 0, 0, 0, 1 } }; + + // Add in a bit of silly fun... + const float time = (float)ImGui::GetTime(); + const bool winning_state = memchr(selected, 0, sizeof(selected)) == NULL; // If all cells are selected... + if (winning_state) + ImGui::PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_SelectableTextAlign, ImVec2(0.5f + 0.5f * cosf(time * 2.0f), 0.5f + 0.5f * sinf(time * 3.0f))); + + for (int y = 0; y < 4; y++) + for (int x = 0; x < 4; x++) + { + if (x > 0) + ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::PushID(y * 4 + x); + if (ImGui::Selectable("Sailor", selected[y][x] != 0, 0, ImVec2(50, 50))) + { + // Toggle clicked cell + toggle neighbors + selected[y][x] ^= 1; + if (x > 0) { selected[y][x - 1] ^= 1; } + if (x < 3) { selected[y][x + 1] ^= 1; } + if (y > 0) { selected[y - 1][x] ^= 1; } + if (y < 3) { selected[y + 1][x] ^= 1; } + } + ImGui::PopID(); + } + + if (winning_state) + ImGui::PopStyleVar(); + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Alignment")) + { + HelpMarker( + "By default, Selectables uses style.SelectableTextAlign but it can be overridden on a per-item " + "basis using PushStyleVar(). You'll probably want to always keep your default situation to " + "left-align otherwise it becomes difficult to layout multiple items on a same line"); + static bool selected[3 * 3] = { true, false, true, false, true, false, true, false, true }; + for (int y = 0; y < 3; y++) + { + for (int x = 0; x < 3; x++) + { + ImVec2 alignment = ImVec2((float)x / 2.0f, (float)y / 2.0f); + char name[32]; + sprintf(name, "(%.1f,%.1f)", alignment.x, alignment.y); + if (x > 0) ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_SelectableTextAlign, alignment); + ImGui::Selectable(name, &selected[3 * y + x], ImGuiSelectableFlags_None, ImVec2(80, 80)); + ImGui::PopStyleVar(); + } + } + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + // To wire InputText() with std::string or any other custom string type, + // see the "Text Input > Resize Callback" section of this demo, and the misc/cpp/imgui_stdlib.h file. + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Text Input")) + { + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Multi-line Text Input")) + { + // Note: we are using a fixed-sized buffer for simplicity here. See ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackResize + // and the code in misc/cpp/imgui_stdlib.h for how to setup InputText() for dynamically resizing strings. + static char text[1024 * 16] = + "/*\n" + " The Pentium F00F bug, shorthand for F0 0F C7 C8,\n" + " the hexadecimal encoding of one offending instruction,\n" + " more formally, the invalid operand with locked CMPXCHG8B\n" + " instruction bug, is a design flaw in the majority of\n" + " Intel Pentium, Pentium MMX, and Pentium OverDrive\n" + " processors (all in the P5 microarchitecture).\n" + "*/\n\n" + "label:\n" + "\tlock cmpxchg8b eax\n"; + + static ImGuiInputTextFlags flags = ImGuiInputTextFlags_AllowTabInput; + HelpMarker("You can use the ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackResize facility if you need to wire InputTextMultiline() to a dynamic string type. See misc/cpp/imgui_stdlib.h for an example. (This is not demonstrated in imgui_demo.cpp because we don't want to include in here)"); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiInputTextFlags_ReadOnly", &flags, ImGuiInputTextFlags_ReadOnly); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiInputTextFlags_AllowTabInput", &flags, ImGuiInputTextFlags_AllowTabInput); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiInputTextFlags_CtrlEnterForNewLine", &flags, ImGuiInputTextFlags_CtrlEnterForNewLine); + ImGui::InputTextMultiline("##source", text, IM_ARRAYSIZE(text), ImVec2(-FLT_MIN, ImGui::GetTextLineHeight() * 16), flags); + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Filtered Text Input")) + { + struct TextFilters + { + // Return 0 (pass) if the character is 'i' or 'm' or 'g' or 'u' or 'i' + static int FilterImGuiLetters(ImGuiInputTextCallbackData* data) + { + if (data->EventChar < 256 && strchr("imgui", (char)data->EventChar)) + return 0; + return 1; + } + }; + + static char buf1[64] = ""; ImGui::InputText("default", buf1, 64); + static char buf2[64] = ""; ImGui::InputText("decimal", buf2, 64, ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsDecimal); + static char buf3[64] = ""; ImGui::InputText("hexadecimal", buf3, 64, ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsHexadecimal | ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsUppercase); + static char buf4[64] = ""; ImGui::InputText("uppercase", buf4, 64, ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsUppercase); + static char buf5[64] = ""; ImGui::InputText("no blank", buf5, 64, ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsNoBlank); + static char buf6[64] = ""; ImGui::InputText("\"imgui\" letters", buf6, 64, ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackCharFilter, TextFilters::FilterImGuiLetters); + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Password Input")) + { + static char password[64] = "password123"; + ImGui::InputText("password", password, IM_ARRAYSIZE(password), ImGuiInputTextFlags_Password); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Display all characters as '*'.\nDisable clipboard cut and copy.\nDisable logging.\n"); + ImGui::InputTextWithHint("password (w/ hint)", "", password, IM_ARRAYSIZE(password), ImGuiInputTextFlags_Password); + ImGui::InputText("password (clear)", password, IM_ARRAYSIZE(password)); + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Completion, History, Edit Callbacks")) + { + struct Funcs + { + static int MyCallback(ImGuiInputTextCallbackData* data) + { + if (data->EventFlag == ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackCompletion) + { + data->InsertChars(data->CursorPos, ".."); + } + else if (data->EventFlag == ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackHistory) + { + if (data->EventKey == ImGuiKey_UpArrow) + { + data->DeleteChars(0, data->BufTextLen); + data->InsertChars(0, "Pressed Up!"); + data->SelectAll(); + } + else if (data->EventKey == ImGuiKey_DownArrow) + { + data->DeleteChars(0, data->BufTextLen); + data->InsertChars(0, "Pressed Down!"); + data->SelectAll(); + } + } + else if (data->EventFlag == ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackEdit) + { + // Toggle casing of first character + char c = data->Buf[0]; + if ((c >= 'a' && c <= 'z') || (c >= 'A' && c <= 'Z')) data->Buf[0] ^= 32; + data->BufDirty = true; + + // Increment a counter + int* p_int = (int*)data->UserData; + *p_int = *p_int + 1; + } + return 0; + } + }; + static char buf1[64]; + ImGui::InputText("Completion", buf1, 64, ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackCompletion, Funcs::MyCallback); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Here we append \"..\" each time Tab is pressed. See 'Examples>Console' for a more meaningful demonstration of using this callback."); + + static char buf2[64]; + ImGui::InputText("History", buf2, 64, ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackHistory, Funcs::MyCallback); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Here we replace and select text each time Up/Down are pressed. See 'Examples>Console' for a more meaningful demonstration of using this callback."); + + static char buf3[64]; + static int edit_count = 0; + ImGui::InputText("Edit", buf3, 64, ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackEdit, Funcs::MyCallback, (void*)&edit_count); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Here we toggle the casing of the first character on every edits + count edits."); + ImGui::SameLine(); ImGui::Text("(%d)", edit_count); + + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Resize Callback")) + { + // To wire InputText() with std::string or any other custom string type, + // you can use the ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackResize flag + create a custom ImGui::InputText() wrapper + // using your preferred type. See misc/cpp/imgui_stdlib.h for an implementation of this using std::string. + HelpMarker( + "Using ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackResize to wire your custom string type to InputText().\n\n" + "See misc/cpp/imgui_stdlib.h for an implementation of this for std::string."); + struct Funcs + { + static int MyResizeCallback(ImGuiInputTextCallbackData* data) + { + if (data->EventFlag == ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackResize) + { + ImVector* my_str = (ImVector*)data->UserData; + IM_ASSERT(my_str->begin() == data->Buf); + my_str->resize(data->BufSize); // NB: On resizing calls, generally data->BufSize == data->BufTextLen + 1 + data->Buf = my_str->begin(); + } + return 0; + } + + // Note: Because ImGui:: is a namespace you would typically add your own function into the namespace. + // For example, you code may declare a function 'ImGui::InputText(const char* label, MyString* my_str)' + static bool MyInputTextMultiline(const char* label, ImVector* my_str, const ImVec2& size = ImVec2(0, 0), ImGuiInputTextFlags flags = 0) + { + IM_ASSERT((flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackResize) == 0); + return ImGui::InputTextMultiline(label, my_str->begin(), (size_t)my_str->size(), size, flags | ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackResize, Funcs::MyResizeCallback, (void*)my_str); + } + }; + + // For this demo we are using ImVector as a string container. + // Note that because we need to store a terminating zero character, our size/capacity are 1 more + // than usually reported by a typical string class. + static ImVector my_str; + if (my_str.empty()) + my_str.push_back(0); + Funcs::MyInputTextMultiline("##MyStr", &my_str, ImVec2(-FLT_MIN, ImGui::GetTextLineHeight() * 16)); + ImGui::Text("Data: %p\nSize: %d\nCapacity: %d", (void*)my_str.begin(), my_str.size(), my_str.capacity()); + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + // Tabs + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Tabs")) + { + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Basic")) + { + ImGuiTabBarFlags tab_bar_flags = ImGuiTabBarFlags_None; + if (ImGui::BeginTabBar("MyTabBar", tab_bar_flags)) + { + if (ImGui::BeginTabItem("Avocado")) + { + ImGui::Text("This is the Avocado tab!\nblah blah blah blah blah"); + ImGui::EndTabItem(); + } + if (ImGui::BeginTabItem("Broccoli")) + { + ImGui::Text("This is the Broccoli tab!\nblah blah blah blah blah"); + ImGui::EndTabItem(); + } + if (ImGui::BeginTabItem("Cucumber")) + { + ImGui::Text("This is the Cucumber tab!\nblah blah blah blah blah"); + ImGui::EndTabItem(); + } + ImGui::EndTabBar(); + } + ImGui::Separator(); + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Advanced & Close Button")) + { + // Expose a couple of the available flags. In most cases you may just call BeginTabBar() with no flags (0). + static ImGuiTabBarFlags tab_bar_flags = ImGuiTabBarFlags_Reorderable; + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTabBarFlags_Reorderable", &tab_bar_flags, ImGuiTabBarFlags_Reorderable); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTabBarFlags_AutoSelectNewTabs", &tab_bar_flags, ImGuiTabBarFlags_AutoSelectNewTabs); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTabBarFlags_TabListPopupButton", &tab_bar_flags, ImGuiTabBarFlags_TabListPopupButton); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTabBarFlags_NoCloseWithMiddleMouseButton", &tab_bar_flags, ImGuiTabBarFlags_NoCloseWithMiddleMouseButton); + if ((tab_bar_flags & ImGuiTabBarFlags_FittingPolicyMask_) == 0) + tab_bar_flags |= ImGuiTabBarFlags_FittingPolicyDefault_; + if (ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTabBarFlags_FittingPolicyResizeDown", &tab_bar_flags, ImGuiTabBarFlags_FittingPolicyResizeDown)) + tab_bar_flags &= ~(ImGuiTabBarFlags_FittingPolicyMask_ ^ ImGuiTabBarFlags_FittingPolicyResizeDown); + if (ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTabBarFlags_FittingPolicyScroll", &tab_bar_flags, ImGuiTabBarFlags_FittingPolicyScroll)) + tab_bar_flags &= ~(ImGuiTabBarFlags_FittingPolicyMask_ ^ ImGuiTabBarFlags_FittingPolicyScroll); + + // Tab Bar + const char* names[4] = { "Artichoke", "Beetroot", "Celery", "Daikon" }; + static bool opened[4] = { true, true, true, true }; // Persistent user state + for (int n = 0; n < IM_ARRAYSIZE(opened); n++) + { + if (n > 0) { ImGui::SameLine(); } + ImGui::Checkbox(names[n], &opened[n]); + } + + // Passing a bool* to BeginTabItem() is similar to passing one to Begin(): + // the underlying bool will be set to false when the tab is closed. + if (ImGui::BeginTabBar("MyTabBar", tab_bar_flags)) + { + for (int n = 0; n < IM_ARRAYSIZE(opened); n++) + if (opened[n] && ImGui::BeginTabItem(names[n], &opened[n], ImGuiTabItemFlags_None)) + { + ImGui::Text("This is the %s tab!", names[n]); + if (n & 1) + ImGui::Text("I am an odd tab."); + ImGui::EndTabItem(); + } + ImGui::EndTabBar(); + } + ImGui::Separator(); + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (ImGui::TreeNode("TabItemButton & Leading/Trailing flags")) + { + static ImVector active_tabs; + static int next_tab_id = 0; + if (next_tab_id == 0) // Initialize with some default tabs + for (int i = 0; i < 3; i++) + active_tabs.push_back(next_tab_id++); + + // TabItemButton() and Leading/Trailing flags are distinct features which we will demo together. + // (It is possible to submit regular tabs with Leading/Trailing flags, or TabItemButton tabs without Leading/Trailing flags... + // but they tend to make more sense together) + static bool show_leading_button = true; + static bool show_trailing_button = true; + ImGui::Checkbox("Show Leading TabItemButton()", &show_leading_button); + ImGui::Checkbox("Show Trailing TabItemButton()", &show_trailing_button); + + // Expose some other flags which are useful to showcase how they interact with Leading/Trailing tabs + static ImGuiTabBarFlags tab_bar_flags = ImGuiTabBarFlags_AutoSelectNewTabs | ImGuiTabBarFlags_Reorderable | ImGuiTabBarFlags_FittingPolicyResizeDown; + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTabBarFlags_TabListPopupButton", &tab_bar_flags, ImGuiTabBarFlags_TabListPopupButton); + if (ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTabBarFlags_FittingPolicyResizeDown", &tab_bar_flags, ImGuiTabBarFlags_FittingPolicyResizeDown)) + tab_bar_flags &= ~(ImGuiTabBarFlags_FittingPolicyMask_ ^ ImGuiTabBarFlags_FittingPolicyResizeDown); + if (ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTabBarFlags_FittingPolicyScroll", &tab_bar_flags, ImGuiTabBarFlags_FittingPolicyScroll)) + tab_bar_flags &= ~(ImGuiTabBarFlags_FittingPolicyMask_ ^ ImGuiTabBarFlags_FittingPolicyScroll); + + if (ImGui::BeginTabBar("MyTabBar", tab_bar_flags)) + { + // Demo a Leading TabItemButton(): click the "?" button to open a menu + if (show_leading_button) + if (ImGui::TabItemButton("?", ImGuiTabItemFlags_Leading | ImGuiTabItemFlags_NoTooltip)) + ImGui::OpenPopup("MyHelpMenu"); + if (ImGui::BeginPopup("MyHelpMenu")) + { + ImGui::Selectable("Hello!"); + ImGui::EndPopup(); + } + + // Demo Trailing Tabs: click the "+" button to add a new tab (in your app you may want to use a font icon instead of the "+") + // Note that we submit it before the regular tabs, but because of the ImGuiTabItemFlags_Trailing flag it will always appear at the end. + if (show_trailing_button) + if (ImGui::TabItemButton("+", ImGuiTabItemFlags_Trailing | ImGuiTabItemFlags_NoTooltip)) + active_tabs.push_back(next_tab_id++); // Add new tab + + // Submit our regular tabs + for (int n = 0; n < active_tabs.Size; ) + { + bool open = true; + char name[16]; + snprintf(name, IM_ARRAYSIZE(name), "%04d", active_tabs[n]); + if (ImGui::BeginTabItem(name, &open, ImGuiTabItemFlags_None)) + { + ImGui::Text("This is the %s tab!", name); + ImGui::EndTabItem(); + } + + if (!open) + active_tabs.erase(active_tabs.Data + n); + else + n++; + } + + ImGui::EndTabBar(); + } + ImGui::Separator(); + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + // Plot/Graph widgets are not very good. + // Consider writing your own, or using a third-party one, see: + // - ImPlot https://github.com/epezent/implot + // - others https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/wiki/Useful-Extensions + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Plots Widgets")) + { + static bool animate = true; + ImGui::Checkbox("Animate", &animate); + + static float arr[] = { 0.6f, 0.1f, 1.0f, 0.5f, 0.92f, 0.1f, 0.2f }; + ImGui::PlotLines("Frame Times", arr, IM_ARRAYSIZE(arr)); + + // Fill an array of contiguous float values to plot + // Tip: If your float aren't contiguous but part of a structure, you can pass a pointer to your first float + // and the sizeof() of your structure in the "stride" parameter. + static float values[90] = {}; + static int values_offset = 0; + static double refresh_time = 0.0; + if (!animate || refresh_time == 0.0) + refresh_time = ImGui::GetTime(); + while (refresh_time < ImGui::GetTime()) // Create data at fixed 60 Hz rate for the demo + { + static float phase = 0.0f; + values[values_offset] = cosf(phase); + values_offset = (values_offset + 1) % IM_ARRAYSIZE(values); + phase += 0.10f * values_offset; + refresh_time += 1.0f / 60.0f; + } + + // Plots can display overlay texts + // (in this example, we will display an average value) + { + float average = 0.0f; + for (int n = 0; n < IM_ARRAYSIZE(values); n++) + average += values[n]; + average /= (float)IM_ARRAYSIZE(values); + char overlay[32]; + sprintf(overlay, "avg %f", average); + ImGui::PlotLines("Lines", values, IM_ARRAYSIZE(values), values_offset, overlay, -1.0f, 1.0f, ImVec2(0, 80.0f)); + } + ImGui::PlotHistogram("Histogram", arr, IM_ARRAYSIZE(arr), 0, NULL, 0.0f, 1.0f, ImVec2(0, 80.0f)); + + // Use functions to generate output + // FIXME: This is rather awkward because current plot API only pass in indices. + // We probably want an API passing floats and user provide sample rate/count. + struct Funcs + { + static float Sin(void*, int i) { return sinf(i * 0.1f); } + static float Saw(void*, int i) { return (i & 1) ? 1.0f : -1.0f; } + }; + static int func_type = 0, display_count = 70; + ImGui::Separator(); + ImGui::SetNextItemWidth(ImGui::GetFontSize() * 8); + ImGui::Combo("func", &func_type, "Sin\0Saw\0"); + ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::SliderInt("Sample count", &display_count, 1, 400); + float (*func)(void*, int) = (func_type == 0) ? Funcs::Sin : Funcs::Saw; + ImGui::PlotLines("Lines", func, NULL, display_count, 0, NULL, -1.0f, 1.0f, ImVec2(0, 80)); + ImGui::PlotHistogram("Histogram", func, NULL, display_count, 0, NULL, -1.0f, 1.0f, ImVec2(0, 80)); + ImGui::Separator(); + + // Animate a simple progress bar + static float progress = 0.0f, progress_dir = 1.0f; + if (animate) + { + progress += progress_dir * 0.4f * ImGui::GetIO().DeltaTime; + if (progress >= +1.1f) { progress = +1.1f; progress_dir *= -1.0f; } + if (progress <= -0.1f) { progress = -0.1f; progress_dir *= -1.0f; } + } + + // Typically we would use ImVec2(-1.0f,0.0f) or ImVec2(-FLT_MIN,0.0f) to use all available width, + // or ImVec2(width,0.0f) for a specified width. ImVec2(0.0f,0.0f) uses ItemWidth. + ImGui::ProgressBar(progress, ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f)); + ImGui::SameLine(0.0f, ImGui::GetStyle().ItemInnerSpacing.x); + ImGui::Text("Progress Bar"); + + float progress_saturated = IM_CLAMP(progress, 0.0f, 1.0f); + char buf[32]; + sprintf(buf, "%d/%d", (int)(progress_saturated * 1753), 1753); + ImGui::ProgressBar(progress, ImVec2(0.f, 0.f), buf); + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Color/Picker Widgets")) + { + static ImVec4 color = ImVec4(114.0f / 255.0f, 144.0f / 255.0f, 154.0f / 255.0f, 200.0f / 255.0f); + + static bool alpha_preview = true; + static bool alpha_half_preview = false; + static bool drag_and_drop = true; + static bool options_menu = true; + static bool hdr = false; + ImGui::Checkbox("With Alpha Preview", &alpha_preview); + ImGui::Checkbox("With Half Alpha Preview", &alpha_half_preview); + ImGui::Checkbox("With Drag and Drop", &drag_and_drop); + ImGui::Checkbox("With Options Menu", &options_menu); ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Right-click on the individual color widget to show options."); + ImGui::Checkbox("With HDR", &hdr); ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Currently all this does is to lift the 0..1 limits on dragging widgets."); + ImGuiColorEditFlags misc_flags = (hdr ? ImGuiColorEditFlags_HDR : 0) | (drag_and_drop ? 0 : ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoDragDrop) | (alpha_half_preview ? ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaPreviewHalf : (alpha_preview ? ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaPreview : 0)) | (options_menu ? 0 : ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoOptions); + + ImGui::Text("Color widget:"); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker( + "Click on the color square to open a color picker.\n" + "CTRL+click on individual component to input value.\n"); + ImGui::ColorEdit3("MyColor##1", (float*)&color, misc_flags); + + ImGui::Text("Color widget HSV with Alpha:"); + ImGui::ColorEdit4("MyColor##2", (float*)&color, ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayHSV | misc_flags); + + ImGui::Text("Color widget with Float Display:"); + ImGui::ColorEdit4("MyColor##2f", (float*)&color, ImGuiColorEditFlags_Float | misc_flags); + + ImGui::Text("Color button with Picker:"); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker( + "With the ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoInputs flag you can hide all the slider/text inputs.\n" + "With the ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoLabel flag you can pass a non-empty label which will only " + "be used for the tooltip and picker popup."); + ImGui::ColorEdit4("MyColor##3", (float*)&color, ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoInputs | ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoLabel | misc_flags); + + ImGui::Text("Color button with Custom Picker Popup:"); + + // Generate a default palette. The palette will persist and can be edited. + static bool saved_palette_init = true; + static ImVec4 saved_palette[32] = {}; + if (saved_palette_init) + { + for (int n = 0; n < IM_ARRAYSIZE(saved_palette); n++) + { + ImGui::ColorConvertHSVtoRGB(n / 31.0f, 0.8f, 0.8f, + saved_palette[n].x, saved_palette[n].y, saved_palette[n].z); + saved_palette[n].w = 1.0f; // Alpha + } + saved_palette_init = false; + } + + static ImVec4 backup_color; + bool open_popup = ImGui::ColorButton("MyColor##3b", color, misc_flags); + ImGui::SameLine(0, ImGui::GetStyle().ItemInnerSpacing.x); + open_popup |= ImGui::Button("Palette"); + if (open_popup) + { + ImGui::OpenPopup("mypicker"); + backup_color = color; + } + if (ImGui::BeginPopup("mypicker")) + { + ImGui::Text("MY CUSTOM COLOR PICKER WITH AN AMAZING PALETTE!"); + ImGui::Separator(); + ImGui::ColorPicker4("##picker", (float*)&color, misc_flags | ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoSidePreview | ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoSmallPreview); + ImGui::SameLine(); + + ImGui::BeginGroup(); // Lock X position + ImGui::Text("Current"); + ImGui::ColorButton("##current", color, ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoPicker | ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaPreviewHalf, ImVec2(60, 40)); + ImGui::Text("Previous"); + if (ImGui::ColorButton("##previous", backup_color, ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoPicker | ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaPreviewHalf, ImVec2(60, 40))) + color = backup_color; + ImGui::Separator(); + ImGui::Text("Palette"); + for (int n = 0; n < IM_ARRAYSIZE(saved_palette); n++) + { + ImGui::PushID(n); + if ((n % 8) != 0) + ImGui::SameLine(0.0f, ImGui::GetStyle().ItemSpacing.y); + + ImGuiColorEditFlags palette_button_flags = ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha | ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoPicker | ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoTooltip; + if (ImGui::ColorButton("##palette", saved_palette[n], palette_button_flags, ImVec2(20, 20))) + color = ImVec4(saved_palette[n].x, saved_palette[n].y, saved_palette[n].z, color.w); // Preserve alpha! + + // Allow user to drop colors into each palette entry. Note that ColorButton() is already a + // drag source by default, unless specifying the ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoDragDrop flag. + if (ImGui::BeginDragDropTarget()) + { + if (const ImGuiPayload* payload = ImGui::AcceptDragDropPayload(IMGUI_PAYLOAD_TYPE_COLOR_3F)) + memcpy((float*)&saved_palette[n], payload->Data, sizeof(float) * 3); + if (const ImGuiPayload* payload = ImGui::AcceptDragDropPayload(IMGUI_PAYLOAD_TYPE_COLOR_4F)) + memcpy((float*)&saved_palette[n], payload->Data, sizeof(float) * 4); + ImGui::EndDragDropTarget(); + } + + ImGui::PopID(); + } + ImGui::EndGroup(); + ImGui::EndPopup(); + } + + ImGui::Text("Color button only:"); + static bool no_border = false; + ImGui::Checkbox("ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoBorder", &no_border); + ImGui::ColorButton("MyColor##3c", *(ImVec4*)&color, misc_flags | (no_border ? ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoBorder : 0), ImVec2(80, 80)); + + ImGui::Text("Color picker:"); + static bool alpha = true; + static bool alpha_bar = true; + static bool side_preview = true; + static bool ref_color = false; + static ImVec4 ref_color_v(1.0f, 0.0f, 1.0f, 0.5f); + static int display_mode = 0; + static int picker_mode = 0; + ImGui::Checkbox("With Alpha", &alpha); + ImGui::Checkbox("With Alpha Bar", &alpha_bar); + ImGui::Checkbox("With Side Preview", &side_preview); + if (side_preview) + { + ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::Checkbox("With Ref Color", &ref_color); + if (ref_color) + { + ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::ColorEdit4("##RefColor", &ref_color_v.x, ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoInputs | misc_flags); + } + } + ImGui::Combo("Display Mode", &display_mode, "Auto/Current\0None\0RGB Only\0HSV Only\0Hex Only\0"); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker( + "ColorEdit defaults to displaying RGB inputs if you don't specify a display mode, " + "but the user can change it with a right-click.\n\nColorPicker defaults to displaying RGB+HSV+Hex " + "if you don't specify a display mode.\n\nYou can change the defaults using SetColorEditOptions()."); + ImGui::Combo("Picker Mode", &picker_mode, "Auto/Current\0Hue bar + SV rect\0Hue wheel + SV triangle\0"); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("User can right-click the picker to change mode."); + ImGuiColorEditFlags flags = misc_flags; + if (!alpha) flags |= ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha; // This is by default if you call ColorPicker3() instead of ColorPicker4() + if (alpha_bar) flags |= ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaBar; + if (!side_preview) flags |= ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoSidePreview; + if (picker_mode == 1) flags |= ImGuiColorEditFlags_PickerHueBar; + if (picker_mode == 2) flags |= ImGuiColorEditFlags_PickerHueWheel; + if (display_mode == 1) flags |= ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoInputs; // Disable all RGB/HSV/Hex displays + if (display_mode == 2) flags |= ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayRGB; // Override display mode + if (display_mode == 3) flags |= ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayHSV; + if (display_mode == 4) flags |= ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayHex; + ImGui::ColorPicker4("MyColor##4", (float*)&color, flags, ref_color ? &ref_color_v.x : NULL); + + ImGui::Text("Set defaults in code:"); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker( + "SetColorEditOptions() is designed to allow you to set boot-time default.\n" + "We don't have Push/Pop functions because you can force options on a per-widget basis if needed," + "and the user can change non-forced ones with the options menu.\nWe don't have a getter to avoid" + "encouraging you to persistently save values that aren't forward-compatible."); + if (ImGui::Button("Default: Uint8 + HSV + Hue Bar")) + ImGui::SetColorEditOptions(ImGuiColorEditFlags_Uint8 | ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayHSV | ImGuiColorEditFlags_PickerHueBar); + if (ImGui::Button("Default: Float + HDR + Hue Wheel")) + ImGui::SetColorEditOptions(ImGuiColorEditFlags_Float | ImGuiColorEditFlags_HDR | ImGuiColorEditFlags_PickerHueWheel); + + // HSV encoded support (to avoid RGB<>HSV round trips and singularities when S==0 or V==0) + static ImVec4 color_hsv(0.23f, 1.0f, 1.0f, 1.0f); // Stored as HSV! + ImGui::Spacing(); + ImGui::Text("HSV encoded colors"); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker( + "By default, colors are given to ColorEdit and ColorPicker in RGB, but ImGuiColorEditFlags_InputHSV" + "allows you to store colors as HSV and pass them to ColorEdit and ColorPicker as HSV. This comes with the" + "added benefit that you can manipulate hue values with the picker even when saturation or value are zero."); + ImGui::Text("Color widget with InputHSV:"); + ImGui::ColorEdit4("HSV shown as RGB##1", (float*)&color_hsv, ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayRGB | ImGuiColorEditFlags_InputHSV | ImGuiColorEditFlags_Float); + ImGui::ColorEdit4("HSV shown as HSV##1", (float*)&color_hsv, ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayHSV | ImGuiColorEditFlags_InputHSV | ImGuiColorEditFlags_Float); + ImGui::DragFloat4("Raw HSV values", (float*)&color_hsv, 0.01f, 0.0f, 1.0f); + + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Drag/Slider Flags")) + { + // Demonstrate using advanced flags for DragXXX and SliderXXX functions. Note that the flags are the same! + static ImGuiSliderFlags flags = ImGuiSliderFlags_None; + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiSliderFlags_AlwaysClamp", &flags, ImGuiSliderFlags_AlwaysClamp); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Always clamp value to min/max bounds (if any) when input manually with CTRL+Click."); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiSliderFlags_Logarithmic", &flags, ImGuiSliderFlags_Logarithmic); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Enable logarithmic editing (more precision for small values)."); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiSliderFlags_NoRoundToFormat", &flags, ImGuiSliderFlags_NoRoundToFormat); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Disable rounding underlying value to match precision of the format string (e.g. %.3f values are rounded to those 3 digits)."); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiSliderFlags_NoInput", &flags, ImGuiSliderFlags_NoInput); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Disable CTRL+Click or Enter key allowing to input text directly into the widget."); + + // Drags + static float drag_f = 0.5f; + static int drag_i = 50; + ImGui::Text("Underlying float value: %f", drag_f); + ImGui::DragFloat("DragFloat (0 -> 1)", &drag_f, 0.005f, 0.0f, 1.0f, "%.3f", flags); + ImGui::DragFloat("DragFloat (0 -> +inf)", &drag_f, 0.005f, 0.0f, FLT_MAX, "%.3f", flags); + ImGui::DragFloat("DragFloat (-inf -> 1)", &drag_f, 0.005f, -FLT_MAX, 1.0f, "%.3f", flags); + ImGui::DragFloat("DragFloat (-inf -> +inf)", &drag_f, 0.005f, -FLT_MAX, +FLT_MAX, "%.3f", flags); + ImGui::DragInt("DragInt (0 -> 100)", &drag_i, 0.5f, 0, 100, "%d", flags); + + // Sliders + static float slider_f = 0.5f; + static int slider_i = 50; + ImGui::Text("Underlying float value: %f", slider_f); + ImGui::SliderFloat("SliderFloat (0 -> 1)", &slider_f, 0.0f, 1.0f, "%.3f", flags); + ImGui::SliderInt("SliderInt (0 -> 100)", &slider_i, 0, 100, "%d", flags); + + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Range Widgets")) + { + static float begin = 10, end = 90; + static int begin_i = 100, end_i = 1000; + ImGui::DragFloatRange2("range float", &begin, &end, 0.25f, 0.0f, 100.0f, "Min: %.1f %%", "Max: %.1f %%", ImGuiSliderFlags_AlwaysClamp); + ImGui::DragIntRange2("range int", &begin_i, &end_i, 5, 0, 1000, "Min: %d units", "Max: %d units"); + ImGui::DragIntRange2("range int (no bounds)", &begin_i, &end_i, 5, 0, 0, "Min: %d units", "Max: %d units"); + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Data Types")) + { + // DragScalar/InputScalar/SliderScalar functions allow various data types + // - signed/unsigned + // - 8/16/32/64-bits + // - integer/float/double + // To avoid polluting the public API with all possible combinations, we use the ImGuiDataType enum + // to pass the type, and passing all arguments by pointer. + // This is the reason the test code below creates local variables to hold "zero" "one" etc. for each types. + // In practice, if you frequently use a given type that is not covered by the normal API entry points, + // you can wrap it yourself inside a 1 line function which can take typed argument as value instead of void*, + // and then pass their address to the generic function. For example: + // bool MySliderU64(const char *label, u64* value, u64 min = 0, u64 max = 0, const char* format = "%lld") + // { + // return SliderScalar(label, ImGuiDataType_U64, value, &min, &max, format); + // } + + // Setup limits (as helper variables so we can take their address, as explained above) + // Note: SliderScalar() functions have a maximum usable range of half the natural type maximum, hence the /2. + #ifndef LLONG_MIN + ImS64 LLONG_MIN = -9223372036854775807LL - 1; + ImS64 LLONG_MAX = 9223372036854775807LL; + ImU64 ULLONG_MAX = (2ULL * 9223372036854775807LL + 1); + #endif + const char s8_zero = 0, s8_one = 1, s8_fifty = 50, s8_min = -128, s8_max = 127; + const ImU8 u8_zero = 0, u8_one = 1, u8_fifty = 50, u8_min = 0, u8_max = 255; + const short s16_zero = 0, s16_one = 1, s16_fifty = 50, s16_min = -32768, s16_max = 32767; + const ImU16 u16_zero = 0, u16_one = 1, u16_fifty = 50, u16_min = 0, u16_max = 65535; + const ImS32 s32_zero = 0, s32_one = 1, s32_fifty = 50, s32_min = INT_MIN/2, s32_max = INT_MAX/2, s32_hi_a = INT_MAX/2 - 100, s32_hi_b = INT_MAX/2; + const ImU32 u32_zero = 0, u32_one = 1, u32_fifty = 50, u32_min = 0, u32_max = UINT_MAX/2, u32_hi_a = UINT_MAX/2 - 100, u32_hi_b = UINT_MAX/2; + const ImS64 s64_zero = 0, s64_one = 1, s64_fifty = 50, s64_min = LLONG_MIN/2, s64_max = LLONG_MAX/2, s64_hi_a = LLONG_MAX/2 - 100, s64_hi_b = LLONG_MAX/2; + const ImU64 u64_zero = 0, u64_one = 1, u64_fifty = 50, u64_min = 0, u64_max = ULLONG_MAX/2, u64_hi_a = ULLONG_MAX/2 - 100, u64_hi_b = ULLONG_MAX/2; + const float f32_zero = 0.f, f32_one = 1.f, f32_lo_a = -10000000000.0f, f32_hi_a = +10000000000.0f; + const double f64_zero = 0., f64_one = 1., f64_lo_a = -1000000000000000.0, f64_hi_a = +1000000000000000.0; + + // State + static char s8_v = 127; + static ImU8 u8_v = 255; + static short s16_v = 32767; + static ImU16 u16_v = 65535; + static ImS32 s32_v = -1; + static ImU32 u32_v = (ImU32)-1; + static ImS64 s64_v = -1; + static ImU64 u64_v = (ImU64)-1; + static float f32_v = 0.123f; + static double f64_v = 90000.01234567890123456789; + + const float drag_speed = 0.2f; + static bool drag_clamp = false; + ImGui::Text("Drags:"); + ImGui::Checkbox("Clamp integers to 0..50", &drag_clamp); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker( + "As with every widgets in dear imgui, we never modify values unless there is a user interaction.\n" + "You can override the clamping limits by using CTRL+Click to input a value."); + ImGui::DragScalar("drag s8", ImGuiDataType_S8, &s8_v, drag_speed, drag_clamp ? &s8_zero : NULL, drag_clamp ? &s8_fifty : NULL); + ImGui::DragScalar("drag u8", ImGuiDataType_U8, &u8_v, drag_speed, drag_clamp ? &u8_zero : NULL, drag_clamp ? &u8_fifty : NULL, "%u ms"); + ImGui::DragScalar("drag s16", ImGuiDataType_S16, &s16_v, drag_speed, drag_clamp ? &s16_zero : NULL, drag_clamp ? &s16_fifty : NULL); + ImGui::DragScalar("drag u16", ImGuiDataType_U16, &u16_v, drag_speed, drag_clamp ? &u16_zero : NULL, drag_clamp ? &u16_fifty : NULL, "%u ms"); + ImGui::DragScalar("drag s32", ImGuiDataType_S32, &s32_v, drag_speed, drag_clamp ? &s32_zero : NULL, drag_clamp ? &s32_fifty : NULL); + ImGui::DragScalar("drag u32", ImGuiDataType_U32, &u32_v, drag_speed, drag_clamp ? &u32_zero : NULL, drag_clamp ? &u32_fifty : NULL, "%u ms"); + ImGui::DragScalar("drag s64", ImGuiDataType_S64, &s64_v, drag_speed, drag_clamp ? &s64_zero : NULL, drag_clamp ? &s64_fifty : NULL); + ImGui::DragScalar("drag u64", ImGuiDataType_U64, &u64_v, drag_speed, drag_clamp ? &u64_zero : NULL, drag_clamp ? &u64_fifty : NULL); + ImGui::DragScalar("drag float", ImGuiDataType_Float, &f32_v, 0.005f, &f32_zero, &f32_one, "%f"); + ImGui::DragScalar("drag float log", ImGuiDataType_Float, &f32_v, 0.005f, &f32_zero, &f32_one, "%f", ImGuiSliderFlags_Logarithmic); + ImGui::DragScalar("drag double", ImGuiDataType_Double, &f64_v, 0.0005f, &f64_zero, NULL, "%.10f grams"); + ImGui::DragScalar("drag double log",ImGuiDataType_Double, &f64_v, 0.0005f, &f64_zero, &f64_one, "0 < %.10f < 1", ImGuiSliderFlags_Logarithmic); + + ImGui::Text("Sliders"); + ImGui::SliderScalar("slider s8 full", ImGuiDataType_S8, &s8_v, &s8_min, &s8_max, "%d"); + ImGui::SliderScalar("slider u8 full", ImGuiDataType_U8, &u8_v, &u8_min, &u8_max, "%u"); + ImGui::SliderScalar("slider s16 full", ImGuiDataType_S16, &s16_v, &s16_min, &s16_max, "%d"); + ImGui::SliderScalar("slider u16 full", ImGuiDataType_U16, &u16_v, &u16_min, &u16_max, "%u"); + ImGui::SliderScalar("slider s32 low", ImGuiDataType_S32, &s32_v, &s32_zero, &s32_fifty,"%d"); + ImGui::SliderScalar("slider s32 high", ImGuiDataType_S32, &s32_v, &s32_hi_a, &s32_hi_b, "%d"); + ImGui::SliderScalar("slider s32 full", ImGuiDataType_S32, &s32_v, &s32_min, &s32_max, "%d"); + ImGui::SliderScalar("slider u32 low", ImGuiDataType_U32, &u32_v, &u32_zero, &u32_fifty,"%u"); + ImGui::SliderScalar("slider u32 high", ImGuiDataType_U32, &u32_v, &u32_hi_a, &u32_hi_b, "%u"); + ImGui::SliderScalar("slider u32 full", ImGuiDataType_U32, &u32_v, &u32_min, &u32_max, "%u"); + ImGui::SliderScalar("slider s64 low", ImGuiDataType_S64, &s64_v, &s64_zero, &s64_fifty,"%" IM_PRId64); + ImGui::SliderScalar("slider s64 high", ImGuiDataType_S64, &s64_v, &s64_hi_a, &s64_hi_b, "%" IM_PRId64); + ImGui::SliderScalar("slider s64 full", ImGuiDataType_S64, &s64_v, &s64_min, &s64_max, "%" IM_PRId64); + ImGui::SliderScalar("slider u64 low", ImGuiDataType_U64, &u64_v, &u64_zero, &u64_fifty,"%" IM_PRIu64 " ms"); + ImGui::SliderScalar("slider u64 high", ImGuiDataType_U64, &u64_v, &u64_hi_a, &u64_hi_b, "%" IM_PRIu64 " ms"); + ImGui::SliderScalar("slider u64 full", ImGuiDataType_U64, &u64_v, &u64_min, &u64_max, "%" IM_PRIu64 " ms"); + ImGui::SliderScalar("slider float low", ImGuiDataType_Float, &f32_v, &f32_zero, &f32_one); + ImGui::SliderScalar("slider float low log", ImGuiDataType_Float, &f32_v, &f32_zero, &f32_one, "%.10f", ImGuiSliderFlags_Logarithmic); + ImGui::SliderScalar("slider float high", ImGuiDataType_Float, &f32_v, &f32_lo_a, &f32_hi_a, "%e"); + ImGui::SliderScalar("slider double low", ImGuiDataType_Double, &f64_v, &f64_zero, &f64_one, "%.10f grams"); + ImGui::SliderScalar("slider double low log",ImGuiDataType_Double, &f64_v, &f64_zero, &f64_one, "%.10f", ImGuiSliderFlags_Logarithmic); + ImGui::SliderScalar("slider double high", ImGuiDataType_Double, &f64_v, &f64_lo_a, &f64_hi_a, "%e grams"); + + ImGui::Text("Sliders (reverse)"); + ImGui::SliderScalar("slider s8 reverse", ImGuiDataType_S8, &s8_v, &s8_max, &s8_min, "%d"); + ImGui::SliderScalar("slider u8 reverse", ImGuiDataType_U8, &u8_v, &u8_max, &u8_min, "%u"); + ImGui::SliderScalar("slider s32 reverse", ImGuiDataType_S32, &s32_v, &s32_fifty, &s32_zero, "%d"); + ImGui::SliderScalar("slider u32 reverse", ImGuiDataType_U32, &u32_v, &u32_fifty, &u32_zero, "%u"); + ImGui::SliderScalar("slider s64 reverse", ImGuiDataType_S64, &s64_v, &s64_fifty, &s64_zero, "%" IM_PRId64); + ImGui::SliderScalar("slider u64 reverse", ImGuiDataType_U64, &u64_v, &u64_fifty, &u64_zero, "%" IM_PRIu64 " ms"); + + static bool inputs_step = true; + ImGui::Text("Inputs"); + ImGui::Checkbox("Show step buttons", &inputs_step); + ImGui::InputScalar("input s8", ImGuiDataType_S8, &s8_v, inputs_step ? &s8_one : NULL, NULL, "%d"); + ImGui::InputScalar("input u8", ImGuiDataType_U8, &u8_v, inputs_step ? &u8_one : NULL, NULL, "%u"); + ImGui::InputScalar("input s16", ImGuiDataType_S16, &s16_v, inputs_step ? &s16_one : NULL, NULL, "%d"); + ImGui::InputScalar("input u16", ImGuiDataType_U16, &u16_v, inputs_step ? &u16_one : NULL, NULL, "%u"); + ImGui::InputScalar("input s32", ImGuiDataType_S32, &s32_v, inputs_step ? &s32_one : NULL, NULL, "%d"); + ImGui::InputScalar("input s32 hex", ImGuiDataType_S32, &s32_v, inputs_step ? &s32_one : NULL, NULL, "%08X", ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsHexadecimal); + ImGui::InputScalar("input u32", ImGuiDataType_U32, &u32_v, inputs_step ? &u32_one : NULL, NULL, "%u"); + ImGui::InputScalar("input u32 hex", ImGuiDataType_U32, &u32_v, inputs_step ? &u32_one : NULL, NULL, "%08X", ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsHexadecimal); + ImGui::InputScalar("input s64", ImGuiDataType_S64, &s64_v, inputs_step ? &s64_one : NULL); + ImGui::InputScalar("input u64", ImGuiDataType_U64, &u64_v, inputs_step ? &u64_one : NULL); + ImGui::InputScalar("input float", ImGuiDataType_Float, &f32_v, inputs_step ? &f32_one : NULL); + ImGui::InputScalar("input double", ImGuiDataType_Double, &f64_v, inputs_step ? &f64_one : NULL); + + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Multi-component Widgets")) + { + static float vec4f[4] = { 0.10f, 0.20f, 0.30f, 0.44f }; + static int vec4i[4] = { 1, 5, 100, 255 }; + + ImGui::InputFloat2("input float2", vec4f); + ImGui::DragFloat2("drag float2", vec4f, 0.01f, 0.0f, 1.0f); + ImGui::SliderFloat2("slider float2", vec4f, 0.0f, 1.0f); + ImGui::InputInt2("input int2", vec4i); + ImGui::DragInt2("drag int2", vec4i, 1, 0, 255); + ImGui::SliderInt2("slider int2", vec4i, 0, 255); + ImGui::Spacing(); + + ImGui::InputFloat3("input float3", vec4f); + ImGui::DragFloat3("drag float3", vec4f, 0.01f, 0.0f, 1.0f); + ImGui::SliderFloat3("slider float3", vec4f, 0.0f, 1.0f); + ImGui::InputInt3("input int3", vec4i); + ImGui::DragInt3("drag int3", vec4i, 1, 0, 255); + ImGui::SliderInt3("slider int3", vec4i, 0, 255); + ImGui::Spacing(); + + ImGui::InputFloat4("input float4", vec4f); + ImGui::DragFloat4("drag float4", vec4f, 0.01f, 0.0f, 1.0f); + ImGui::SliderFloat4("slider float4", vec4f, 0.0f, 1.0f); + ImGui::InputInt4("input int4", vec4i); + ImGui::DragInt4("drag int4", vec4i, 1, 0, 255); + ImGui::SliderInt4("slider int4", vec4i, 0, 255); + + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Vertical Sliders")) + { + const float spacing = 4; + ImGui::PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_ItemSpacing, ImVec2(spacing, spacing)); + + static int int_value = 0; + ImGui::VSliderInt("##int", ImVec2(18, 160), &int_value, 0, 5); + ImGui::SameLine(); + + static float values[7] = { 0.0f, 0.60f, 0.35f, 0.9f, 0.70f, 0.20f, 0.0f }; + ImGui::PushID("set1"); + for (int i = 0; i < 7; i++) + { + if (i > 0) ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::PushID(i); + ImGui::PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_FrameBg, (ImVec4)ImColor::HSV(i / 7.0f, 0.5f, 0.5f)); + ImGui::PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_FrameBgHovered, (ImVec4)ImColor::HSV(i / 7.0f, 0.6f, 0.5f)); + ImGui::PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_FrameBgActive, (ImVec4)ImColor::HSV(i / 7.0f, 0.7f, 0.5f)); + ImGui::PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_SliderGrab, (ImVec4)ImColor::HSV(i / 7.0f, 0.9f, 0.9f)); + ImGui::VSliderFloat("##v", ImVec2(18, 160), &values[i], 0.0f, 1.0f, ""); + if (ImGui::IsItemActive() || ImGui::IsItemHovered()) + ImGui::SetTooltip("%.3f", values[i]); + ImGui::PopStyleColor(4); + ImGui::PopID(); + } + ImGui::PopID(); + + ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::PushID("set2"); + static float values2[4] = { 0.20f, 0.80f, 0.40f, 0.25f }; + const int rows = 3; + const ImVec2 small_slider_size(18, (float)(int)((160.0f - (rows - 1) * spacing) / rows)); + for (int nx = 0; nx < 4; nx++) + { + if (nx > 0) ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::BeginGroup(); + for (int ny = 0; ny < rows; ny++) + { + ImGui::PushID(nx * rows + ny); + ImGui::VSliderFloat("##v", small_slider_size, &values2[nx], 0.0f, 1.0f, ""); + if (ImGui::IsItemActive() || ImGui::IsItemHovered()) + ImGui::SetTooltip("%.3f", values2[nx]); + ImGui::PopID(); + } + ImGui::EndGroup(); + } + ImGui::PopID(); + + ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::PushID("set3"); + for (int i = 0; i < 4; i++) + { + if (i > 0) ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::PushID(i); + ImGui::PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_GrabMinSize, 40); + ImGui::VSliderFloat("##v", ImVec2(40, 160), &values[i], 0.0f, 1.0f, "%.2f\nsec"); + ImGui::PopStyleVar(); + ImGui::PopID(); + } + ImGui::PopID(); + ImGui::PopStyleVar(); + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Drag and Drop")) + { + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Drag and drop in standard widgets")) + { + // ColorEdit widgets automatically act as drag source and drag target. + // They are using standardized payload strings IMGUI_PAYLOAD_TYPE_COLOR_3F and IMGUI_PAYLOAD_TYPE_COLOR_4F + // to allow your own widgets to use colors in their drag and drop interaction. + // Also see 'Demo->Widgets->Color/Picker Widgets->Palette' demo. + HelpMarker("You can drag from the color squares."); + static float col1[3] = { 1.0f, 0.0f, 0.2f }; + static float col2[4] = { 0.4f, 0.7f, 0.0f, 0.5f }; + ImGui::ColorEdit3("color 1", col1); + ImGui::ColorEdit4("color 2", col2); + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Drag and drop to copy/swap items")) + { + enum Mode + { + Mode_Copy, + Mode_Move, + Mode_Swap + }; + static int mode = 0; + if (ImGui::RadioButton("Copy", mode == Mode_Copy)) { mode = Mode_Copy; } ImGui::SameLine(); + if (ImGui::RadioButton("Move", mode == Mode_Move)) { mode = Mode_Move; } ImGui::SameLine(); + if (ImGui::RadioButton("Swap", mode == Mode_Swap)) { mode = Mode_Swap; } + static const char* names[9] = + { + "Bobby", "Beatrice", "Betty", + "Brianna", "Barry", "Bernard", + "Bibi", "Blaine", "Bryn" + }; + for (int n = 0; n < IM_ARRAYSIZE(names); n++) + { + ImGui::PushID(n); + if ((n % 3) != 0) + ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::Button(names[n], ImVec2(60, 60)); + + // Our buttons are both drag sources and drag targets here! + if (ImGui::BeginDragDropSource(ImGuiDragDropFlags_None)) + { + // Set payload to carry the index of our item (could be anything) + ImGui::SetDragDropPayload("DND_DEMO_CELL", &n, sizeof(int)); + + // Display preview (could be anything, e.g. when dragging an image we could decide to display + // the filename and a small preview of the image, etc.) + if (mode == Mode_Copy) { ImGui::Text("Copy %s", names[n]); } + if (mode == Mode_Move) { ImGui::Text("Move %s", names[n]); } + if (mode == Mode_Swap) { ImGui::Text("Swap %s", names[n]); } + ImGui::EndDragDropSource(); + } + if (ImGui::BeginDragDropTarget()) + { + if (const ImGuiPayload* payload = ImGui::AcceptDragDropPayload("DND_DEMO_CELL")) + { + IM_ASSERT(payload->DataSize == sizeof(int)); + int payload_n = *(const int*)payload->Data; + if (mode == Mode_Copy) + { + names[n] = names[payload_n]; + } + if (mode == Mode_Move) + { + names[n] = names[payload_n]; + names[payload_n] = ""; + } + if (mode == Mode_Swap) + { + const char* tmp = names[n]; + names[n] = names[payload_n]; + names[payload_n] = tmp; + } + } + ImGui::EndDragDropTarget(); + } + ImGui::PopID(); + } + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Drag to reorder items (simple)")) + { + // Simple reordering + HelpMarker( + "We don't use the drag and drop api at all here! " + "Instead we query when the item is held but not hovered, and order items accordingly."); + static const char* item_names[] = { "Item One", "Item Two", "Item Three", "Item Four", "Item Five" }; + for (int n = 0; n < IM_ARRAYSIZE(item_names); n++) + { + const char* item = item_names[n]; + ImGui::Selectable(item); + + if (ImGui::IsItemActive() && !ImGui::IsItemHovered()) + { + int n_next = n + (ImGui::GetMouseDragDelta(0).y < 0.f ? -1 : 1); + if (n_next >= 0 && n_next < IM_ARRAYSIZE(item_names)) + { + item_names[n] = item_names[n_next]; + item_names[n_next] = item; + ImGui::ResetMouseDragDelta(); + } + } + } + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Querying Status (Edited/Active/Hovered etc.)")) + { + // Select an item type + const char* item_names[] = + { + "Text", "Button", "Button (w/ repeat)", "Checkbox", "SliderFloat", "InputText", "InputFloat", + "InputFloat3", "ColorEdit4", "Selectable", "MenuItem", "TreeNode", "TreeNode (w/ double-click)", "Combo", "ListBox" + }; + static int item_type = 4; + static bool item_disabled = false; + ImGui::Combo("Item Type", &item_type, item_names, IM_ARRAYSIZE(item_names), IM_ARRAYSIZE(item_names)); + ImGui::SameLine(); + HelpMarker("Testing how various types of items are interacting with the IsItemXXX functions. Note that the bool return value of most ImGui function is generally equivalent to calling ImGui::IsItemHovered()."); + ImGui::Checkbox("Item Disabled", &item_disabled); + + // Submit selected item item so we can query their status in the code following it. + bool ret = false; + static bool b = false; + static float col4f[4] = { 1.0f, 0.5, 0.0f, 1.0f }; + static char str[16] = {}; + if (item_disabled) + ImGui::BeginDisabled(true); + if (item_type == 0) { ImGui::Text("ITEM: Text"); } // Testing text items with no identifier/interaction + if (item_type == 1) { ret = ImGui::Button("ITEM: Button"); } // Testing button + if (item_type == 2) { ImGui::PushButtonRepeat(true); ret = ImGui::Button("ITEM: Button"); ImGui::PopButtonRepeat(); } // Testing button (with repeater) + if (item_type == 3) { ret = ImGui::Checkbox("ITEM: Checkbox", &b); } // Testing checkbox + if (item_type == 4) { ret = ImGui::SliderFloat("ITEM: SliderFloat", &col4f[0], 0.0f, 1.0f); } // Testing basic item + if (item_type == 5) { ret = ImGui::InputText("ITEM: InputText", &str[0], IM_ARRAYSIZE(str)); } // Testing input text (which handles tabbing) + if (item_type == 6) { ret = ImGui::InputFloat("ITEM: InputFloat", col4f, 1.0f); } // Testing +/- buttons on scalar input + if (item_type == 7) { ret = ImGui::InputFloat3("ITEM: InputFloat3", col4f); } // Testing multi-component items (IsItemXXX flags are reported merged) + if (item_type == 8) { ret = ImGui::ColorEdit4("ITEM: ColorEdit4", col4f); } // Testing multi-component items (IsItemXXX flags are reported merged) + if (item_type == 9) { ret = ImGui::Selectable("ITEM: Selectable"); } // Testing selectable item + if (item_type == 10){ ret = ImGui::MenuItem("ITEM: MenuItem"); } // Testing menu item (they use ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnRelease button policy) + if (item_type == 11){ ret = ImGui::TreeNode("ITEM: TreeNode"); if (ret) ImGui::TreePop(); } // Testing tree node + if (item_type == 12){ ret = ImGui::TreeNodeEx("ITEM: TreeNode w/ ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_OpenOnDoubleClick", ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_OpenOnDoubleClick | ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NoTreePushOnOpen); } // Testing tree node with ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnDoubleClick button policy. + if (item_type == 13){ const char* items[] = { "Apple", "Banana", "Cherry", "Kiwi" }; static int current = 1; ret = ImGui::Combo("ITEM: Combo", ¤t, items, IM_ARRAYSIZE(items)); } + if (item_type == 14){ const char* items[] = { "Apple", "Banana", "Cherry", "Kiwi" }; static int current = 1; ret = ImGui::ListBox("ITEM: ListBox", ¤t, items, IM_ARRAYSIZE(items), IM_ARRAYSIZE(items)); } + + // Display the values of IsItemHovered() and other common item state functions. + // Note that the ImGuiHoveredFlags_XXX flags can be combined. + // Because BulletText is an item itself and that would affect the output of IsItemXXX functions, + // we query every state in a single call to avoid storing them and to simplify the code. + ImGui::BulletText( + "Return value = %d\n" + "IsItemFocused() = %d\n" + "IsItemHovered() = %d\n" + "IsItemHovered(_AllowWhenBlockedByPopup) = %d\n" + "IsItemHovered(_AllowWhenBlockedByActiveItem) = %d\n" + "IsItemHovered(_AllowWhenOverlapped) = %d\n" + "IsItemHovered(_AllowWhenDisabled) = %d\n" + "IsItemHovered(_RectOnly) = %d\n" + "IsItemActive() = %d\n" + "IsItemEdited() = %d\n" + "IsItemActivated() = %d\n" + "IsItemDeactivated() = %d\n" + "IsItemDeactivatedAfterEdit() = %d\n" + "IsItemVisible() = %d\n" + "IsItemClicked() = %d\n" + "IsItemToggledOpen() = %d\n" + "GetItemRectMin() = (%.1f, %.1f)\n" + "GetItemRectMax() = (%.1f, %.1f)\n" + "GetItemRectSize() = (%.1f, %.1f)", + ret, + ImGui::IsItemFocused(), + ImGui::IsItemHovered(), + ImGui::IsItemHovered(ImGuiHoveredFlags_AllowWhenBlockedByPopup), + ImGui::IsItemHovered(ImGuiHoveredFlags_AllowWhenBlockedByActiveItem), + ImGui::IsItemHovered(ImGuiHoveredFlags_AllowWhenOverlapped), + ImGui::IsItemHovered(ImGuiHoveredFlags_AllowWhenDisabled), + ImGui::IsItemHovered(ImGuiHoveredFlags_RectOnly), + ImGui::IsItemActive(), + ImGui::IsItemEdited(), + ImGui::IsItemActivated(), + ImGui::IsItemDeactivated(), + ImGui::IsItemDeactivatedAfterEdit(), + ImGui::IsItemVisible(), + ImGui::IsItemClicked(), + ImGui::IsItemToggledOpen(), + ImGui::GetItemRectMin().x, ImGui::GetItemRectMin().y, + ImGui::GetItemRectMax().x, ImGui::GetItemRectMax().y, + ImGui::GetItemRectSize().x, ImGui::GetItemRectSize().y + ); + + if (item_disabled) + ImGui::EndDisabled(); + + static bool embed_all_inside_a_child_window = false; + ImGui::Checkbox("Embed everything inside a child window (for additional testing)", &embed_all_inside_a_child_window); + if (embed_all_inside_a_child_window) + ImGui::BeginChild("outer_child", ImVec2(0, ImGui::GetFontSize() * 20.0f), true); + + // Testing IsWindowFocused() function with its various flags. + // Note that the ImGuiFocusedFlags_XXX flags can be combined. + ImGui::BulletText( + "IsWindowFocused() = %d\n" + "IsWindowFocused(_ChildWindows) = %d\n" + "IsWindowFocused(_ChildWindows|_RootWindow) = %d\n" + "IsWindowFocused(_RootWindow) = %d\n" + "IsWindowFocused(_AnyWindow) = %d\n", + ImGui::IsWindowFocused(), + ImGui::IsWindowFocused(ImGuiFocusedFlags_ChildWindows), + ImGui::IsWindowFocused(ImGuiFocusedFlags_ChildWindows | ImGuiFocusedFlags_RootWindow), + ImGui::IsWindowFocused(ImGuiFocusedFlags_RootWindow), + ImGui::IsWindowFocused(ImGuiFocusedFlags_AnyWindow)); + + // Testing IsWindowHovered() function with its various flags. + // Note that the ImGuiHoveredFlags_XXX flags can be combined. + ImGui::BulletText( + "IsWindowHovered() = %d\n" + "IsWindowHovered(_AllowWhenBlockedByPopup) = %d\n" + "IsWindowHovered(_AllowWhenBlockedByActiveItem) = %d\n" + "IsWindowHovered(_ChildWindows) = %d\n" + "IsWindowHovered(_ChildWindows|_RootWindow) = %d\n" + "IsWindowHovered(_ChildWindows|_AllowWhenBlockedByPopup) = %d\n" + "IsWindowHovered(_RootWindow) = %d\n" + "IsWindowHovered(_AnyWindow) = %d\n", + ImGui::IsWindowHovered(), + ImGui::IsWindowHovered(ImGuiHoveredFlags_AllowWhenBlockedByPopup), + ImGui::IsWindowHovered(ImGuiHoveredFlags_AllowWhenBlockedByActiveItem), + ImGui::IsWindowHovered(ImGuiHoveredFlags_ChildWindows), + ImGui::IsWindowHovered(ImGuiHoveredFlags_ChildWindows | ImGuiHoveredFlags_RootWindow), + ImGui::IsWindowHovered(ImGuiHoveredFlags_ChildWindows | ImGuiHoveredFlags_AllowWhenBlockedByPopup), + ImGui::IsWindowHovered(ImGuiHoveredFlags_RootWindow), + ImGui::IsWindowHovered(ImGuiHoveredFlags_AnyWindow)); + + ImGui::BeginChild("child", ImVec2(0, 50), true); + ImGui::Text("This is another child window for testing the _ChildWindows flag."); + ImGui::EndChild(); + if (embed_all_inside_a_child_window) + ImGui::EndChild(); + + static char unused_str[] = "This widget is only here to be able to tab-out of the widgets above."; + ImGui::InputText("unused", unused_str, IM_ARRAYSIZE(unused_str), ImGuiInputTextFlags_ReadOnly); + + // Calling IsItemHovered() after begin returns the hovered status of the title bar. + // This is useful in particular if you want to create a context menu associated to the title bar of a window. + static bool test_window = false; + ImGui::Checkbox("Hovered/Active tests after Begin() for title bar testing", &test_window); + if (test_window) + { + ImGui::Begin("Title bar Hovered/Active tests", &test_window); + if (ImGui::BeginPopupContextItem()) // <-- This is using IsItemHovered() + { + if (ImGui::MenuItem("Close")) { test_window = false; } + ImGui::EndPopup(); + } + ImGui::Text( + "IsItemHovered() after begin = %d (== is title bar hovered)\n" + "IsItemActive() after begin = %d (== is window being clicked/moved)\n", + ImGui::IsItemHovered(), ImGui::IsItemActive()); + ImGui::End(); + } + + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + // Demonstrate BeginDisabled/EndDisabled using a checkbox located at the bottom of the section (which is a bit odd: + // logically we'd have this checkbox at the top of the section, but we don't want this feature to steal that space) + if (disable_all) + ImGui::EndDisabled(); + + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Disable block")) + { + ImGui::Checkbox("Disable entire section above", &disable_all); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Demonstrate using BeginDisabled()/EndDisabled() across this section."); + ImGui::TreePop(); + } +} + +static void ShowDemoWindowLayout() +{ + if (!ImGui::CollapsingHeader("Layout & Scrolling")) + return; + + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Child windows")) + { + HelpMarker("Use child windows to begin into a self-contained independent scrolling/clipping regions within a host window."); + static bool disable_mouse_wheel = false; + static bool disable_menu = false; + ImGui::Checkbox("Disable Mouse Wheel", &disable_mouse_wheel); + ImGui::Checkbox("Disable Menu", &disable_menu); + + // Child 1: no border, enable horizontal scrollbar + { + ImGuiWindowFlags window_flags = ImGuiWindowFlags_HorizontalScrollbar; + if (disable_mouse_wheel) + window_flags |= ImGuiWindowFlags_NoScrollWithMouse; + ImGui::BeginChild("ChildL", ImVec2(ImGui::GetWindowContentRegionWidth() * 0.5f, 260), false, window_flags); + for (int i = 0; i < 100; i++) + ImGui::Text("%04d: scrollable region", i); + ImGui::EndChild(); + } + + ImGui::SameLine(); + + // Child 2: rounded border + { + ImGuiWindowFlags window_flags = ImGuiWindowFlags_None; + if (disable_mouse_wheel) + window_flags |= ImGuiWindowFlags_NoScrollWithMouse; + if (!disable_menu) + window_flags |= ImGuiWindowFlags_MenuBar; + ImGui::PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_ChildRounding, 5.0f); + ImGui::BeginChild("ChildR", ImVec2(0, 260), true, window_flags); + if (!disable_menu && ImGui::BeginMenuBar()) + { + if (ImGui::BeginMenu("Menu")) + { + ShowExampleMenuFile(); + ImGui::EndMenu(); + } + ImGui::EndMenuBar(); + } + if (ImGui::BeginTable("split", 2, ImGuiTableFlags_Resizable | ImGuiTableFlags_NoSavedSettings)) + { + for (int i = 0; i < 100; i++) + { + char buf[32]; + sprintf(buf, "%03d", i); + ImGui::TableNextColumn(); + ImGui::Button(buf, ImVec2(-FLT_MIN, 0.0f)); + } + ImGui::EndTable(); + } + ImGui::EndChild(); + ImGui::PopStyleVar(); + } + + ImGui::Separator(); + + // Demonstrate a few extra things + // - Changing ImGuiCol_ChildBg (which is transparent black in default styles) + // - Using SetCursorPos() to position child window (the child window is an item from the POV of parent window) + // You can also call SetNextWindowPos() to position the child window. The parent window will effectively + // layout from this position. + // - Using ImGui::GetItemRectMin/Max() to query the "item" state (because the child window is an item from + // the POV of the parent window). See 'Demo->Querying Status (Edited/Active/Hovered etc.)' for details. + { + static int offset_x = 0; + ImGui::SetNextItemWidth(ImGui::GetFontSize() * 8); + ImGui::DragInt("Offset X", &offset_x, 1.0f, -1000, 1000); + + ImGui::SetCursorPosX(ImGui::GetCursorPosX() + (float)offset_x); + ImGui::PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_ChildBg, IM_COL32(255, 0, 0, 100)); + ImGui::BeginChild("Red", ImVec2(200, 100), true, ImGuiWindowFlags_None); + for (int n = 0; n < 50; n++) + ImGui::Text("Some test %d", n); + ImGui::EndChild(); + bool child_is_hovered = ImGui::IsItemHovered(); + ImVec2 child_rect_min = ImGui::GetItemRectMin(); + ImVec2 child_rect_max = ImGui::GetItemRectMax(); + ImGui::PopStyleColor(); + ImGui::Text("Hovered: %d", child_is_hovered); + ImGui::Text("Rect of child window is: (%.0f,%.0f) (%.0f,%.0f)", child_rect_min.x, child_rect_min.y, child_rect_max.x, child_rect_max.y); + } + + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Widgets Width")) + { + static float f = 0.0f; + static bool show_indented_items = true; + ImGui::Checkbox("Show indented items", &show_indented_items); + + // Use SetNextItemWidth() to set the width of a single upcoming item. + // Use PushItemWidth()/PopItemWidth() to set the width of a group of items. + // In real code use you'll probably want to choose width values that are proportional to your font size + // e.g. Using '20.0f * GetFontSize()' as width instead of '200.0f', etc. + + ImGui::Text("SetNextItemWidth/PushItemWidth(100)"); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Fixed width."); + ImGui::PushItemWidth(100); + ImGui::DragFloat("float##1b", &f); + if (show_indented_items) + { + ImGui::Indent(); + ImGui::DragFloat("float (indented)##1b", &f); + ImGui::Unindent(); + } + ImGui::PopItemWidth(); + + ImGui::Text("SetNextItemWidth/PushItemWidth(-100)"); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Align to right edge minus 100"); + ImGui::PushItemWidth(-100); + ImGui::DragFloat("float##2a", &f); + if (show_indented_items) + { + ImGui::Indent(); + ImGui::DragFloat("float (indented)##2b", &f); + ImGui::Unindent(); + } + ImGui::PopItemWidth(); + + ImGui::Text("SetNextItemWidth/PushItemWidth(GetContentRegionAvail().x * 0.5f)"); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Half of available width.\n(~ right-cursor_pos)\n(works within a column set)"); + ImGui::PushItemWidth(ImGui::GetContentRegionAvail().x * 0.5f); + ImGui::DragFloat("float##3a", &f); + if (show_indented_items) + { + ImGui::Indent(); + ImGui::DragFloat("float (indented)##3b", &f); + ImGui::Unindent(); + } + ImGui::PopItemWidth(); + + ImGui::Text("SetNextItemWidth/PushItemWidth(-GetContentRegionAvail().x * 0.5f)"); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Align to right edge minus half"); + ImGui::PushItemWidth(-ImGui::GetContentRegionAvail().x * 0.5f); + ImGui::DragFloat("float##4a", &f); + if (show_indented_items) + { + ImGui::Indent(); + ImGui::DragFloat("float (indented)##4b", &f); + ImGui::Unindent(); + } + ImGui::PopItemWidth(); + + // Demonstrate using PushItemWidth to surround three items. + // Calling SetNextItemWidth() before each of them would have the same effect. + ImGui::Text("SetNextItemWidth/PushItemWidth(-FLT_MIN)"); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Align to right edge"); + ImGui::PushItemWidth(-FLT_MIN); + ImGui::DragFloat("##float5a", &f); + if (show_indented_items) + { + ImGui::Indent(); + ImGui::DragFloat("float (indented)##5b", &f); + ImGui::Unindent(); + } + ImGui::PopItemWidth(); + + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Basic Horizontal Layout")) + { + ImGui::TextWrapped("(Use ImGui::SameLine() to keep adding items to the right of the preceding item)"); + + // Text + ImGui::Text("Two items: Hello"); ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::TextColored(ImVec4(1,1,0,1), "Sailor"); + + // Adjust spacing + ImGui::Text("More spacing: Hello"); ImGui::SameLine(0, 20); + ImGui::TextColored(ImVec4(1,1,0,1), "Sailor"); + + // Button + ImGui::AlignTextToFramePadding(); + ImGui::Text("Normal buttons"); ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::Button("Banana"); ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::Button("Apple"); ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::Button("Corniflower"); + + // Button + ImGui::Text("Small buttons"); ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::SmallButton("Like this one"); ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::Text("can fit within a text block."); + + // Aligned to arbitrary position. Easy/cheap column. + ImGui::Text("Aligned"); + ImGui::SameLine(150); ImGui::Text("x=150"); + ImGui::SameLine(300); ImGui::Text("x=300"); + ImGui::Text("Aligned"); + ImGui::SameLine(150); ImGui::SmallButton("x=150"); + ImGui::SameLine(300); ImGui::SmallButton("x=300"); + + // Checkbox + static bool c1 = false, c2 = false, c3 = false, c4 = false; + ImGui::Checkbox("My", &c1); ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::Checkbox("Tailor", &c2); ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::Checkbox("Is", &c3); ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::Checkbox("Rich", &c4); + + // Various + static float f0 = 1.0f, f1 = 2.0f, f2 = 3.0f; + ImGui::PushItemWidth(80); + const char* items[] = { "AAAA", "BBBB", "CCCC", "DDDD" }; + static int item = -1; + ImGui::Combo("Combo", &item, items, IM_ARRAYSIZE(items)); ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::SliderFloat("X", &f0, 0.0f, 5.0f); ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::SliderFloat("Y", &f1, 0.0f, 5.0f); ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::SliderFloat("Z", &f2, 0.0f, 5.0f); + ImGui::PopItemWidth(); + + ImGui::PushItemWidth(80); + ImGui::Text("Lists:"); + static int selection[4] = { 0, 1, 2, 3 }; + for (int i = 0; i < 4; i++) + { + if (i > 0) ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::PushID(i); + ImGui::ListBox("", &selection[i], items, IM_ARRAYSIZE(items)); + ImGui::PopID(); + //if (ImGui::IsItemHovered()) ImGui::SetTooltip("ListBox %d hovered", i); + } + ImGui::PopItemWidth(); + + // Dummy + ImVec2 button_sz(40, 40); + ImGui::Button("A", button_sz); ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::Dummy(button_sz); ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::Button("B", button_sz); + + // Manually wrapping + // (we should eventually provide this as an automatic layout feature, but for now you can do it manually) + ImGui::Text("Manually wrapping:"); + ImGuiStyle& style = ImGui::GetStyle(); + int buttons_count = 20; + float window_visible_x2 = ImGui::GetWindowPos().x + ImGui::GetWindowContentRegionMax().x; + for (int n = 0; n < buttons_count; n++) + { + ImGui::PushID(n); + ImGui::Button("Box", button_sz); + float last_button_x2 = ImGui::GetItemRectMax().x; + float next_button_x2 = last_button_x2 + style.ItemSpacing.x + button_sz.x; // Expected position if next button was on same line + if (n + 1 < buttons_count && next_button_x2 < window_visible_x2) + ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::PopID(); + } + + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Groups")) + { + HelpMarker( + "BeginGroup() basically locks the horizontal position for new line. " + "EndGroup() bundles the whole group so that you can use \"item\" functions such as " + "IsItemHovered()/IsItemActive() or SameLine() etc. on the whole group."); + ImGui::BeginGroup(); + { + ImGui::BeginGroup(); + ImGui::Button("AAA"); + ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::Button("BBB"); + ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::BeginGroup(); + ImGui::Button("CCC"); + ImGui::Button("DDD"); + ImGui::EndGroup(); + ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::Button("EEE"); + ImGui::EndGroup(); + if (ImGui::IsItemHovered()) + ImGui::SetTooltip("First group hovered"); + } + // Capture the group size and create widgets using the same size + ImVec2 size = ImGui::GetItemRectSize(); + const float values[5] = { 0.5f, 0.20f, 0.80f, 0.60f, 0.25f }; + ImGui::PlotHistogram("##values", values, IM_ARRAYSIZE(values), 0, NULL, 0.0f, 1.0f, size); + + ImGui::Button("ACTION", ImVec2((size.x - ImGui::GetStyle().ItemSpacing.x) * 0.5f, size.y)); + ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::Button("REACTION", ImVec2((size.x - ImGui::GetStyle().ItemSpacing.x) * 0.5f, size.y)); + ImGui::EndGroup(); + ImGui::SameLine(); + + ImGui::Button("LEVERAGE\nBUZZWORD", size); + ImGui::SameLine(); + + if (ImGui::BeginListBox("List", size)) + { + ImGui::Selectable("Selected", true); + ImGui::Selectable("Not Selected", false); + ImGui::EndListBox(); + } + + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Text Baseline Alignment")) + { + { + ImGui::BulletText("Text baseline:"); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker( + "This is testing the vertical alignment that gets applied on text to keep it aligned with widgets. " + "Lines only composed of text or \"small\" widgets use less vertical space than lines with framed widgets."); + ImGui::Indent(); + + ImGui::Text("KO Blahblah"); ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::Button("Some framed item"); ImGui::SameLine(); + HelpMarker("Baseline of button will look misaligned with text.."); + + // If your line starts with text, call AlignTextToFramePadding() to align text to upcoming widgets. + // (because we don't know what's coming after the Text() statement, we need to move the text baseline + // down by FramePadding.y ahead of time) + ImGui::AlignTextToFramePadding(); + ImGui::Text("OK Blahblah"); ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::Button("Some framed item"); ImGui::SameLine(); + HelpMarker("We call AlignTextToFramePadding() to vertically align the text baseline by +FramePadding.y"); + + // SmallButton() uses the same vertical padding as Text + ImGui::Button("TEST##1"); ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::Text("TEST"); ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::SmallButton("TEST##2"); + + // If your line starts with text, call AlignTextToFramePadding() to align text to upcoming widgets. + ImGui::AlignTextToFramePadding(); + ImGui::Text("Text aligned to framed item"); ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::Button("Item##1"); ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::Text("Item"); ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::SmallButton("Item##2"); ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::Button("Item##3"); + + ImGui::Unindent(); + } + + ImGui::Spacing(); + + { + ImGui::BulletText("Multi-line text:"); + ImGui::Indent(); + ImGui::Text("One\nTwo\nThree"); ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::Text("Hello\nWorld"); ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::Text("Banana"); + + ImGui::Text("Banana"); ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::Text("Hello\nWorld"); ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::Text("One\nTwo\nThree"); + + ImGui::Button("HOP##1"); ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::Text("Banana"); ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::Text("Hello\nWorld"); ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::Text("Banana"); + + ImGui::Button("HOP##2"); ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::Text("Hello\nWorld"); ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::Text("Banana"); + ImGui::Unindent(); + } + + ImGui::Spacing(); + + { + ImGui::BulletText("Misc items:"); + ImGui::Indent(); + + // SmallButton() sets FramePadding to zero. Text baseline is aligned to match baseline of previous Button. + ImGui::Button("80x80", ImVec2(80, 80)); + ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::Button("50x50", ImVec2(50, 50)); + ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::Button("Button()"); + ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::SmallButton("SmallButton()"); + + // Tree + const float spacing = ImGui::GetStyle().ItemInnerSpacing.x; + ImGui::Button("Button##1"); + ImGui::SameLine(0.0f, spacing); + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Node##1")) + { + // Placeholder tree data + for (int i = 0; i < 6; i++) + ImGui::BulletText("Item %d..", i); + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + // Vertically align text node a bit lower so it'll be vertically centered with upcoming widget. + // Otherwise you can use SmallButton() (smaller fit). + ImGui::AlignTextToFramePadding(); + + // Common mistake to avoid: if we want to SameLine after TreeNode we need to do it before we add + // other contents below the node. + bool node_open = ImGui::TreeNode("Node##2"); + ImGui::SameLine(0.0f, spacing); ImGui::Button("Button##2"); + if (node_open) + { + // Placeholder tree data + for (int i = 0; i < 6; i++) + ImGui::BulletText("Item %d..", i); + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + // Bullet + ImGui::Button("Button##3"); + ImGui::SameLine(0.0f, spacing); + ImGui::BulletText("Bullet text"); + + ImGui::AlignTextToFramePadding(); + ImGui::BulletText("Node"); + ImGui::SameLine(0.0f, spacing); ImGui::Button("Button##4"); + ImGui::Unindent(); + } + + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Scrolling")) + { + // Vertical scroll functions + HelpMarker("Use SetScrollHereY() or SetScrollFromPosY() to scroll to a given vertical position."); + + static int track_item = 50; + static bool enable_track = true; + static bool enable_extra_decorations = false; + static float scroll_to_off_px = 0.0f; + static float scroll_to_pos_px = 200.0f; + + ImGui::Checkbox("Decoration", &enable_extra_decorations); + + ImGui::Checkbox("Track", &enable_track); + ImGui::PushItemWidth(100); + ImGui::SameLine(140); enable_track |= ImGui::DragInt("##item", &track_item, 0.25f, 0, 99, "Item = %d"); + + bool scroll_to_off = ImGui::Button("Scroll Offset"); + ImGui::SameLine(140); scroll_to_off |= ImGui::DragFloat("##off", &scroll_to_off_px, 1.00f, 0, FLT_MAX, "+%.0f px"); + + bool scroll_to_pos = ImGui::Button("Scroll To Pos"); + ImGui::SameLine(140); scroll_to_pos |= ImGui::DragFloat("##pos", &scroll_to_pos_px, 1.00f, -10, FLT_MAX, "X/Y = %.0f px"); + ImGui::PopItemWidth(); + + if (scroll_to_off || scroll_to_pos) + enable_track = false; + + ImGuiStyle& style = ImGui::GetStyle(); + float child_w = (ImGui::GetContentRegionAvail().x - 4 * style.ItemSpacing.x) / 5; + if (child_w < 1.0f) + child_w = 1.0f; + ImGui::PushID("##VerticalScrolling"); + for (int i = 0; i < 5; i++) + { + if (i > 0) ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::BeginGroup(); + const char* names[] = { "Top", "25%", "Center", "75%", "Bottom" }; + ImGui::TextUnformatted(names[i]); + + const ImGuiWindowFlags child_flags = enable_extra_decorations ? ImGuiWindowFlags_MenuBar : 0; + const ImGuiID child_id = ImGui::GetID((void*)(intptr_t)i); + const bool child_is_visible = ImGui::BeginChild(child_id, ImVec2(child_w, 200.0f), true, child_flags); + if (ImGui::BeginMenuBar()) + { + ImGui::TextUnformatted("abc"); + ImGui::EndMenuBar(); + } + if (scroll_to_off) + ImGui::SetScrollY(scroll_to_off_px); + if (scroll_to_pos) + ImGui::SetScrollFromPosY(ImGui::GetCursorStartPos().y + scroll_to_pos_px, i * 0.25f); + if (child_is_visible) // Avoid calling SetScrollHereY when running with culled items + { + for (int item = 0; item < 100; item++) + { + if (enable_track && item == track_item) + { + ImGui::TextColored(ImVec4(1, 1, 0, 1), "Item %d", item); + ImGui::SetScrollHereY(i * 0.25f); // 0.0f:top, 0.5f:center, 1.0f:bottom + } + else + { + ImGui::Text("Item %d", item); + } + } + } + float scroll_y = ImGui::GetScrollY(); + float scroll_max_y = ImGui::GetScrollMaxY(); + ImGui::EndChild(); + ImGui::Text("%.0f/%.0f", scroll_y, scroll_max_y); + ImGui::EndGroup(); + } + ImGui::PopID(); + + // Horizontal scroll functions + ImGui::Spacing(); + HelpMarker( + "Use SetScrollHereX() or SetScrollFromPosX() to scroll to a given horizontal position.\n\n" + "Because the clipping rectangle of most window hides half worth of WindowPadding on the " + "left/right, using SetScrollFromPosX(+1) will usually result in clipped text whereas the " + "equivalent SetScrollFromPosY(+1) wouldn't."); + ImGui::PushID("##HorizontalScrolling"); + for (int i = 0; i < 5; i++) + { + float child_height = ImGui::GetTextLineHeight() + style.ScrollbarSize + style.WindowPadding.y * 2.0f; + ImGuiWindowFlags child_flags = ImGuiWindowFlags_HorizontalScrollbar | (enable_extra_decorations ? ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysVerticalScrollbar : 0); + ImGuiID child_id = ImGui::GetID((void*)(intptr_t)i); + bool child_is_visible = ImGui::BeginChild(child_id, ImVec2(-100, child_height), true, child_flags); + if (scroll_to_off) + ImGui::SetScrollX(scroll_to_off_px); + if (scroll_to_pos) + ImGui::SetScrollFromPosX(ImGui::GetCursorStartPos().x + scroll_to_pos_px, i * 0.25f); + if (child_is_visible) // Avoid calling SetScrollHereY when running with culled items + { + for (int item = 0; item < 100; item++) + { + if (item > 0) + ImGui::SameLine(); + if (enable_track && item == track_item) + { + ImGui::TextColored(ImVec4(1, 1, 0, 1), "Item %d", item); + ImGui::SetScrollHereX(i * 0.25f); // 0.0f:left, 0.5f:center, 1.0f:right + } + else + { + ImGui::Text("Item %d", item); + } + } + } + float scroll_x = ImGui::GetScrollX(); + float scroll_max_x = ImGui::GetScrollMaxX(); + ImGui::EndChild(); + ImGui::SameLine(); + const char* names[] = { "Left", "25%", "Center", "75%", "Right" }; + ImGui::Text("%s\n%.0f/%.0f", names[i], scroll_x, scroll_max_x); + ImGui::Spacing(); + } + ImGui::PopID(); + + // Miscellaneous Horizontal Scrolling Demo + HelpMarker( + "Horizontal scrolling for a window is enabled via the ImGuiWindowFlags_HorizontalScrollbar flag.\n\n" + "You may want to also explicitly specify content width by using SetNextWindowContentWidth() before Begin()."); + static int lines = 7; + ImGui::SliderInt("Lines", &lines, 1, 15); + ImGui::PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_FrameRounding, 3.0f); + ImGui::PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_FramePadding, ImVec2(2.0f, 1.0f)); + ImVec2 scrolling_child_size = ImVec2(0, ImGui::GetFrameHeightWithSpacing() * 7 + 30); + ImGui::BeginChild("scrolling", scrolling_child_size, true, ImGuiWindowFlags_HorizontalScrollbar); + for (int line = 0; line < lines; line++) + { + // Display random stuff. For the sake of this trivial demo we are using basic Button() + SameLine() + // If you want to create your own time line for a real application you may be better off manipulating + // the cursor position yourself, aka using SetCursorPos/SetCursorScreenPos to position the widgets + // yourself. You may also want to use the lower-level ImDrawList API. + int num_buttons = 10 + ((line & 1) ? line * 9 : line * 3); + for (int n = 0; n < num_buttons; n++) + { + if (n > 0) ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::PushID(n + line * 1000); + char num_buf[16]; + sprintf(num_buf, "%d", n); + const char* label = (!(n % 15)) ? "FizzBuzz" : (!(n % 3)) ? "Fizz" : (!(n % 5)) ? "Buzz" : num_buf; + float hue = n * 0.05f; + ImGui::PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_Button, (ImVec4)ImColor::HSV(hue, 0.6f, 0.6f)); + ImGui::PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_ButtonHovered, (ImVec4)ImColor::HSV(hue, 0.7f, 0.7f)); + ImGui::PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_ButtonActive, (ImVec4)ImColor::HSV(hue, 0.8f, 0.8f)); + ImGui::Button(label, ImVec2(40.0f + sinf((float)(line + n)) * 20.0f, 0.0f)); + ImGui::PopStyleColor(3); + ImGui::PopID(); + } + } + float scroll_x = ImGui::GetScrollX(); + float scroll_max_x = ImGui::GetScrollMaxX(); + ImGui::EndChild(); + ImGui::PopStyleVar(2); + float scroll_x_delta = 0.0f; + ImGui::SmallButton("<<"); + if (ImGui::IsItemActive()) + scroll_x_delta = -ImGui::GetIO().DeltaTime * 1000.0f; + ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::Text("Scroll from code"); ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::SmallButton(">>"); + if (ImGui::IsItemActive()) + scroll_x_delta = +ImGui::GetIO().DeltaTime * 1000.0f; + ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::Text("%.0f/%.0f", scroll_x, scroll_max_x); + if (scroll_x_delta != 0.0f) + { + // Demonstrate a trick: you can use Begin to set yourself in the context of another window + // (here we are already out of your child window) + ImGui::BeginChild("scrolling"); + ImGui::SetScrollX(ImGui::GetScrollX() + scroll_x_delta); + ImGui::EndChild(); + } + ImGui::Spacing(); + + static bool show_horizontal_contents_size_demo_window = false; + ImGui::Checkbox("Show Horizontal contents size demo window", &show_horizontal_contents_size_demo_window); + + if (show_horizontal_contents_size_demo_window) + { + static bool show_h_scrollbar = true; + static bool show_button = true; + static bool show_tree_nodes = true; + static bool show_text_wrapped = false; + static bool show_columns = true; + static bool show_tab_bar = true; + static bool show_child = false; + static bool explicit_content_size = false; + static float contents_size_x = 300.0f; + if (explicit_content_size) + ImGui::SetNextWindowContentSize(ImVec2(contents_size_x, 0.0f)); + ImGui::Begin("Horizontal contents size demo window", &show_horizontal_contents_size_demo_window, show_h_scrollbar ? ImGuiWindowFlags_HorizontalScrollbar : 0); + ImGui::PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_ItemSpacing, ImVec2(2, 0)); + ImGui::PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_FramePadding, ImVec2(2, 0)); + HelpMarker("Test of different widgets react and impact the work rectangle growing when horizontal scrolling is enabled.\n\nUse 'Metrics->Tools->Show windows rectangles' to visualize rectangles."); + ImGui::Checkbox("H-scrollbar", &show_h_scrollbar); + ImGui::Checkbox("Button", &show_button); // Will grow contents size (unless explicitly overwritten) + ImGui::Checkbox("Tree nodes", &show_tree_nodes); // Will grow contents size and display highlight over full width + ImGui::Checkbox("Text wrapped", &show_text_wrapped);// Will grow and use contents size + ImGui::Checkbox("Columns", &show_columns); // Will use contents size + ImGui::Checkbox("Tab bar", &show_tab_bar); // Will use contents size + ImGui::Checkbox("Child", &show_child); // Will grow and use contents size + ImGui::Checkbox("Explicit content size", &explicit_content_size); + ImGui::Text("Scroll %.1f/%.1f %.1f/%.1f", ImGui::GetScrollX(), ImGui::GetScrollMaxX(), ImGui::GetScrollY(), ImGui::GetScrollMaxY()); + if (explicit_content_size) + { + ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::SetNextItemWidth(100); + ImGui::DragFloat("##csx", &contents_size_x); + ImVec2 p = ImGui::GetCursorScreenPos(); + ImGui::GetWindowDrawList()->AddRectFilled(p, ImVec2(p.x + 10, p.y + 10), IM_COL32_WHITE); + ImGui::GetWindowDrawList()->AddRectFilled(ImVec2(p.x + contents_size_x - 10, p.y), ImVec2(p.x + contents_size_x, p.y + 10), IM_COL32_WHITE); + ImGui::Dummy(ImVec2(0, 10)); + } + ImGui::PopStyleVar(2); + ImGui::Separator(); + if (show_button) + { + ImGui::Button("this is a 300-wide button", ImVec2(300, 0)); + } + if (show_tree_nodes) + { + bool open = true; + if (ImGui::TreeNode("this is a tree node")) + { + if (ImGui::TreeNode("another one of those tree node...")) + { + ImGui::Text("Some tree contents"); + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + ImGui::CollapsingHeader("CollapsingHeader", &open); + } + if (show_text_wrapped) + { + ImGui::TextWrapped("This text should automatically wrap on the edge of the work rectangle."); + } + if (show_columns) + { + ImGui::Text("Tables:"); + if (ImGui::BeginTable("table", 4, ImGuiTableFlags_Borders)) + { + for (int n = 0; n < 4; n++) + { + ImGui::TableNextColumn(); + ImGui::Text("Width %.2f", ImGui::GetContentRegionAvail().x); + } + ImGui::EndTable(); + } + ImGui::Text("Columns:"); + ImGui::Columns(4); + for (int n = 0; n < 4; n++) + { + ImGui::Text("Width %.2f", ImGui::GetColumnWidth()); + ImGui::NextColumn(); + } + ImGui::Columns(1); + } + if (show_tab_bar && ImGui::BeginTabBar("Hello")) + { + if (ImGui::BeginTabItem("OneOneOne")) { ImGui::EndTabItem(); } + if (ImGui::BeginTabItem("TwoTwoTwo")) { ImGui::EndTabItem(); } + if (ImGui::BeginTabItem("ThreeThreeThree")) { ImGui::EndTabItem(); } + if (ImGui::BeginTabItem("FourFourFour")) { ImGui::EndTabItem(); } + ImGui::EndTabBar(); + } + if (show_child) + { + ImGui::BeginChild("child", ImVec2(0, 0), true); + ImGui::EndChild(); + } + ImGui::End(); + } + + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Clipping")) + { + static ImVec2 size(100.0f, 100.0f); + static ImVec2 offset(30.0f, 30.0f); + ImGui::DragFloat2("size", (float*)&size, 0.5f, 1.0f, 200.0f, "%.0f"); + ImGui::TextWrapped("(Click and drag to scroll)"); + + for (int n = 0; n < 3; n++) + { + if (n > 0) + ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::PushID(n); + ImGui::BeginGroup(); // Lock X position + + ImGui::InvisibleButton("##empty", size); + if (ImGui::IsItemActive() && ImGui::IsMouseDragging(ImGuiMouseButton_Left)) + { + offset.x += ImGui::GetIO().MouseDelta.x; + offset.y += ImGui::GetIO().MouseDelta.y; + } + const ImVec2 p0 = ImGui::GetItemRectMin(); + const ImVec2 p1 = ImGui::GetItemRectMax(); + const char* text_str = "Line 1 hello\nLine 2 clip me!"; + const ImVec2 text_pos = ImVec2(p0.x + offset.x, p0.y + offset.y); + ImDrawList* draw_list = ImGui::GetWindowDrawList(); + + switch (n) + { + case 0: + HelpMarker( + "Using ImGui::PushClipRect():\n" + "Will alter ImGui hit-testing logic + ImDrawList rendering.\n" + "(use this if you want your clipping rectangle to affect interactions)"); + ImGui::PushClipRect(p0, p1, true); + draw_list->AddRectFilled(p0, p1, IM_COL32(90, 90, 120, 255)); + draw_list->AddText(text_pos, IM_COL32_WHITE, text_str); + ImGui::PopClipRect(); + break; + case 1: + HelpMarker( + "Using ImDrawList::PushClipRect():\n" + "Will alter ImDrawList rendering only.\n" + "(use this as a shortcut if you are only using ImDrawList calls)"); + draw_list->PushClipRect(p0, p1, true); + draw_list->AddRectFilled(p0, p1, IM_COL32(90, 90, 120, 255)); + draw_list->AddText(text_pos, IM_COL32_WHITE, text_str); + draw_list->PopClipRect(); + break; + case 2: + HelpMarker( + "Using ImDrawList::AddText() with a fine ClipRect:\n" + "Will alter only this specific ImDrawList::AddText() rendering.\n" + "(this is often used internally to avoid altering the clipping rectangle and minimize draw calls)"); + ImVec4 clip_rect(p0.x, p0.y, p1.x, p1.y); // AddText() takes a ImVec4* here so let's convert. + draw_list->AddRectFilled(p0, p1, IM_COL32(90, 90, 120, 255)); + draw_list->AddText(ImGui::GetFont(), ImGui::GetFontSize(), text_pos, IM_COL32_WHITE, text_str, NULL, 0.0f, &clip_rect); + break; + } + ImGui::EndGroup(); + ImGui::PopID(); + } + + ImGui::TreePop(); + } +} + +static void ShowDemoWindowPopups() +{ + if (!ImGui::CollapsingHeader("Popups & Modal windows")) + return; + + // The properties of popups windows are: + // - They block normal mouse hovering detection outside them. (*) + // - Unless modal, they can be closed by clicking anywhere outside them, or by pressing ESCAPE. + // - Their visibility state (~bool) is held internally by Dear ImGui instead of being held by the programmer as + // we are used to with regular Begin() calls. User can manipulate the visibility state by calling OpenPopup(). + // (*) One can use IsItemHovered(ImGuiHoveredFlags_AllowWhenBlockedByPopup) to bypass it and detect hovering even + // when normally blocked by a popup. + // Those three properties are connected. The library needs to hold their visibility state BECAUSE it can close + // popups at any time. + + // Typical use for regular windows: + // bool my_tool_is_active = false; if (ImGui::Button("Open")) my_tool_is_active = true; [...] if (my_tool_is_active) Begin("My Tool", &my_tool_is_active) { [...] } End(); + // Typical use for popups: + // if (ImGui::Button("Open")) ImGui::OpenPopup("MyPopup"); if (ImGui::BeginPopup("MyPopup") { [...] EndPopup(); } + + // With popups we have to go through a library call (here OpenPopup) to manipulate the visibility state. + // This may be a bit confusing at first but it should quickly make sense. Follow on the examples below. + + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Popups")) + { + ImGui::TextWrapped( + "When a popup is active, it inhibits interacting with windows that are behind the popup. " + "Clicking outside the popup closes it."); + + static int selected_fish = -1; + const char* names[] = { "Bream", "Haddock", "Mackerel", "Pollock", "Tilefish" }; + static bool toggles[] = { true, false, false, false, false }; + + // Simple selection popup (if you want to show the current selection inside the Button itself, + // you may want to build a string using the "###" operator to preserve a constant ID with a variable label) + if (ImGui::Button("Select..")) + ImGui::OpenPopup("my_select_popup"); + ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::TextUnformatted(selected_fish == -1 ? "" : names[selected_fish]); + if (ImGui::BeginPopup("my_select_popup")) + { + ImGui::Text("Aquarium"); + ImGui::Separator(); + for (int i = 0; i < IM_ARRAYSIZE(names); i++) + if (ImGui::Selectable(names[i])) + selected_fish = i; + ImGui::EndPopup(); + } + + // Showing a menu with toggles + if (ImGui::Button("Toggle..")) + ImGui::OpenPopup("my_toggle_popup"); + if (ImGui::BeginPopup("my_toggle_popup")) + { + for (int i = 0; i < IM_ARRAYSIZE(names); i++) + ImGui::MenuItem(names[i], "", &toggles[i]); + if (ImGui::BeginMenu("Sub-menu")) + { + ImGui::MenuItem("Click me"); + ImGui::EndMenu(); + } + + ImGui::Separator(); + ImGui::Text("Tooltip here"); + if (ImGui::IsItemHovered()) + ImGui::SetTooltip("I am a tooltip over a popup"); + + if (ImGui::Button("Stacked Popup")) + ImGui::OpenPopup("another popup"); + if (ImGui::BeginPopup("another popup")) + { + for (int i = 0; i < IM_ARRAYSIZE(names); i++) + ImGui::MenuItem(names[i], "", &toggles[i]); + if (ImGui::BeginMenu("Sub-menu")) + { + ImGui::MenuItem("Click me"); + if (ImGui::Button("Stacked Popup")) + ImGui::OpenPopup("another popup"); + if (ImGui::BeginPopup("another popup")) + { + ImGui::Text("I am the last one here."); + ImGui::EndPopup(); + } + ImGui::EndMenu(); + } + ImGui::EndPopup(); + } + ImGui::EndPopup(); + } + + // Call the more complete ShowExampleMenuFile which we use in various places of this demo + if (ImGui::Button("File Menu..")) + ImGui::OpenPopup("my_file_popup"); + if (ImGui::BeginPopup("my_file_popup")) + { + ShowExampleMenuFile(); + ImGui::EndPopup(); + } + + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Context menus")) + { + HelpMarker("\"Context\" functions are simple helpers to associate a Popup to a given Item or Window identifier."); + + // BeginPopupContextItem() is a helper to provide common/simple popup behavior of essentially doing: + // if (id == 0) + // id = GetItemID(); // Use last item id + // if (IsItemHovered() && IsMouseReleased(ImGuiMouseButton_Right)) + // OpenPopup(id); + // return BeginPopup(id); + // For advanced advanced uses you may want to replicate and customize this code. + // See more details in BeginPopupContextItem(). + + // Example 1 + // When used after an item that has an ID (e.g. Button), we can skip providing an ID to BeginPopupContextItem(), + // and BeginPopupContextItem() will use the last item ID as the popup ID. + { + const char* names[5] = { "Label1", "Label2", "Label3", "Label4", "Label5" }; + for (int n = 0; n < 5; n++) + { + ImGui::Selectable(names[n]); + if (ImGui::BeginPopupContextItem()) // <-- use last item id as popup id + { + ImGui::Text("This a popup for \"%s\"!", names[n]); + if (ImGui::Button("Close")) + ImGui::CloseCurrentPopup(); + ImGui::EndPopup(); + } + if (ImGui::IsItemHovered()) + ImGui::SetTooltip("Right-click to open popup"); + } + } + + // Example 2 + // Popup on a Text() element which doesn't have an identifier: we need to provide an identifier to BeginPopupContextItem(). + // Using an explicit identifier is also convenient if you want to activate the popups from different locations. + { + HelpMarker("Text() elements don't have stable identifiers so we need to provide one."); + static float value = 0.5f; + ImGui::Text("Value = %.3f <-- (1) right-click this value", value); + if (ImGui::BeginPopupContextItem("my popup")) + { + if (ImGui::Selectable("Set to zero")) value = 0.0f; + if (ImGui::Selectable("Set to PI")) value = 3.1415f; + ImGui::SetNextItemWidth(-FLT_MIN); + ImGui::DragFloat("##Value", &value, 0.1f, 0.0f, 0.0f); + ImGui::EndPopup(); + } + + // We can also use OpenPopupOnItemClick() to toggle the visibility of a given popup. + // Here we make it that right-clicking this other text element opens the same popup as above. + // The popup itself will be submitted by the code above. + ImGui::Text("(2) Or right-click this text"); + ImGui::OpenPopupOnItemClick("my popup", ImGuiPopupFlags_MouseButtonRight); + + // Back to square one: manually open the same popup. + if (ImGui::Button("(3) Or click this button")) + ImGui::OpenPopup("my popup"); + } + + // Example 3 + // When using BeginPopupContextItem() with an implicit identifier (NULL == use last item ID), + // we need to make sure your item identifier is stable. + // In this example we showcase altering the item label while preserving its identifier, using the ### operator (see FAQ). + { + HelpMarker("Showcase using a popup ID linked to item ID, with the item having a changing label + stable ID using the ### operator."); + static char name[32] = "Label1"; + char buf[64]; + sprintf(buf, "Button: %s###Button", name); // ### operator override ID ignoring the preceding label + ImGui::Button(buf); + if (ImGui::BeginPopupContextItem()) + { + ImGui::Text("Edit name:"); + ImGui::InputText("##edit", name, IM_ARRAYSIZE(name)); + if (ImGui::Button("Close")) + ImGui::CloseCurrentPopup(); + ImGui::EndPopup(); + } + ImGui::SameLine(); ImGui::Text("(<-- right-click here)"); + } + + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Modals")) + { + ImGui::TextWrapped("Modal windows are like popups but the user cannot close them by clicking outside."); + + if (ImGui::Button("Delete..")) + ImGui::OpenPopup("Delete?"); + + // Always center this window when appearing + ImVec2 center = ImGui::GetMainViewport()->GetCenter(); + ImGui::SetNextWindowPos(center, ImGuiCond_Appearing, ImVec2(0.5f, 0.5f)); + + if (ImGui::BeginPopupModal("Delete?", NULL, ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize)) + { + ImGui::Text("All those beautiful files will be deleted.\nThis operation cannot be undone!\n\n"); + ImGui::Separator(); + + //static int unused_i = 0; + //ImGui::Combo("Combo", &unused_i, "Delete\0Delete harder\0"); + + static bool dont_ask_me_next_time = false; + ImGui::PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_FramePadding, ImVec2(0, 0)); + ImGui::Checkbox("Don't ask me next time", &dont_ask_me_next_time); + ImGui::PopStyleVar(); + + if (ImGui::Button("OK", ImVec2(120, 0))) { ImGui::CloseCurrentPopup(); } + ImGui::SetItemDefaultFocus(); + ImGui::SameLine(); + if (ImGui::Button("Cancel", ImVec2(120, 0))) { ImGui::CloseCurrentPopup(); } + ImGui::EndPopup(); + } + + if (ImGui::Button("Stacked modals..")) + ImGui::OpenPopup("Stacked 1"); + if (ImGui::BeginPopupModal("Stacked 1", NULL, ImGuiWindowFlags_MenuBar)) + { + if (ImGui::BeginMenuBar()) + { + if (ImGui::BeginMenu("File")) + { + if (ImGui::MenuItem("Some menu item")) {} + ImGui::EndMenu(); + } + ImGui::EndMenuBar(); + } + ImGui::Text("Hello from Stacked The First\nUsing style.Colors[ImGuiCol_ModalWindowDimBg] behind it."); + + // Testing behavior of widgets stacking their own regular popups over the modal. + static int item = 1; + static float color[4] = { 0.4f, 0.7f, 0.0f, 0.5f }; + ImGui::Combo("Combo", &item, "aaaa\0bbbb\0cccc\0dddd\0eeee\0\0"); + ImGui::ColorEdit4("color", color); + + if (ImGui::Button("Add another modal..")) + ImGui::OpenPopup("Stacked 2"); + + // Also demonstrate passing a bool* to BeginPopupModal(), this will create a regular close button which + // will close the popup. Note that the visibility state of popups is owned by imgui, so the input value + // of the bool actually doesn't matter here. + bool unused_open = true; + if (ImGui::BeginPopupModal("Stacked 2", &unused_open)) + { + ImGui::Text("Hello from Stacked The Second!"); + if (ImGui::Button("Close")) + ImGui::CloseCurrentPopup(); + ImGui::EndPopup(); + } + + if (ImGui::Button("Close")) + ImGui::CloseCurrentPopup(); + ImGui::EndPopup(); + } + + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Menus inside a regular window")) + { + ImGui::TextWrapped("Below we are testing adding menu items to a regular window. It's rather unusual but should work!"); + ImGui::Separator(); + + // Note: As a quirk in this very specific example, we want to differentiate the parent of this menu from the + // parent of the various popup menus above. To do so we are encloding the items in a PushID()/PopID() block + // to make them two different menusets. If we don't, opening any popup above and hovering our menu here would + // open it. This is because once a menu is active, we allow to switch to a sibling menu by just hovering on it, + // which is the desired behavior for regular menus. + ImGui::PushID("foo"); + ImGui::MenuItem("Menu item", "CTRL+M"); + if (ImGui::BeginMenu("Menu inside a regular window")) + { + ShowExampleMenuFile(); + ImGui::EndMenu(); + } + ImGui::PopID(); + ImGui::Separator(); + ImGui::TreePop(); + } +} + +// Dummy data structure that we use for the Table demo. +// (pre-C++11 doesn't allow us to instantiate ImVector template if this structure if defined inside the demo function) +namespace +{ +// We are passing our own identifier to TableSetupColumn() to facilitate identifying columns in the sorting code. +// This identifier will be passed down into ImGuiTableSortSpec::ColumnUserID. +// But it is possible to omit the user id parameter of TableSetupColumn() and just use the column index instead! (ImGuiTableSortSpec::ColumnIndex) +// If you don't use sorting, you will generally never care about giving column an ID! +enum MyItemColumnID +{ + MyItemColumnID_ID, + MyItemColumnID_Name, + MyItemColumnID_Action, + MyItemColumnID_Quantity, + MyItemColumnID_Description +}; + +struct MyItem +{ + int ID; + const char* Name; + int Quantity; + + // We have a problem which is affecting _only this demo_ and should not affect your code: + // As we don't rely on std:: or other third-party library to compile dear imgui, we only have reliable access to qsort(), + // however qsort doesn't allow passing user data to comparing function. + // As a workaround, we are storing the sort specs in a static/global for the comparing function to access. + // In your own use case you would probably pass the sort specs to your sorting/comparing functions directly and not use a global. + // We could technically call ImGui::TableGetSortSpecs() in CompareWithSortSpecs(), but considering that this function is called + // very often by the sorting algorithm it would be a little wasteful. + static const ImGuiTableSortSpecs* s_current_sort_specs; + + // Compare function to be used by qsort() + static int IMGUI_CDECL CompareWithSortSpecs(const void* lhs, const void* rhs) + { + const MyItem* a = (const MyItem*)lhs; + const MyItem* b = (const MyItem*)rhs; + for (int n = 0; n < s_current_sort_specs->SpecsCount; n++) + { + // Here we identify columns using the ColumnUserID value that we ourselves passed to TableSetupColumn() + // We could also choose to identify columns based on their index (sort_spec->ColumnIndex), which is simpler! + const ImGuiTableColumnSortSpecs* sort_spec = &s_current_sort_specs->Specs[n]; + int delta = 0; + switch (sort_spec->ColumnUserID) + { + case MyItemColumnID_ID: delta = (a->ID - b->ID); break; + case MyItemColumnID_Name: delta = (strcmp(a->Name, b->Name)); break; + case MyItemColumnID_Quantity: delta = (a->Quantity - b->Quantity); break; + case MyItemColumnID_Description: delta = (strcmp(a->Name, b->Name)); break; + default: IM_ASSERT(0); break; + } + if (delta > 0) + return (sort_spec->SortDirection == ImGuiSortDirection_Ascending) ? +1 : -1; + if (delta < 0) + return (sort_spec->SortDirection == ImGuiSortDirection_Ascending) ? -1 : +1; + } + + // qsort() is instable so always return a way to differenciate items. + // Your own compare function may want to avoid fallback on implicit sort specs e.g. a Name compare if it wasn't already part of the sort specs. + return (a->ID - b->ID); + } +}; +const ImGuiTableSortSpecs* MyItem::s_current_sort_specs = NULL; +} + +// Make the UI compact because there are so many fields +static void PushStyleCompact() +{ + ImGuiStyle& style = ImGui::GetStyle(); + ImGui::PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_FramePadding, ImVec2(style.FramePadding.x, (float)(int)(style.FramePadding.y * 0.60f))); + ImGui::PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_ItemSpacing, ImVec2(style.ItemSpacing.x, (float)(int)(style.ItemSpacing.y * 0.60f))); +} + +static void PopStyleCompact() +{ + ImGui::PopStyleVar(2); +} + +// Show a combo box with a choice of sizing policies +static void EditTableSizingFlags(ImGuiTableFlags* p_flags) +{ + struct EnumDesc { ImGuiTableFlags Value; const char* Name; const char* Tooltip; }; + static const EnumDesc policies[] = + { + { ImGuiTableFlags_None, "Default", "Use default sizing policy:\n- ImGuiTableFlags_SizingFixedFit if ScrollX is on or if host window has ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize.\n- ImGuiTableFlags_SizingStretchSame otherwise." }, + { ImGuiTableFlags_SizingFixedFit, "ImGuiTableFlags_SizingFixedFit", "Columns default to _WidthFixed (if resizable) or _WidthAuto (if not resizable), matching contents width." }, + { ImGuiTableFlags_SizingFixedSame, "ImGuiTableFlags_SizingFixedSame", "Columns are all the same width, matching the maximum contents width.\nImplicitly disable ImGuiTableFlags_Resizable and enable ImGuiTableFlags_NoKeepColumnsVisible." }, + { ImGuiTableFlags_SizingStretchProp, "ImGuiTableFlags_SizingStretchProp", "Columns default to _WidthStretch with weights proportional to their widths." }, + { ImGuiTableFlags_SizingStretchSame, "ImGuiTableFlags_SizingStretchSame", "Columns default to _WidthStretch with same weights." } + }; + int idx; + for (idx = 0; idx < IM_ARRAYSIZE(policies); idx++) + if (policies[idx].Value == (*p_flags & ImGuiTableFlags_SizingMask_)) + break; + const char* preview_text = (idx < IM_ARRAYSIZE(policies)) ? policies[idx].Name + (idx > 0 ? strlen("ImGuiTableFlags") : 0) : ""; + if (ImGui::BeginCombo("Sizing Policy", preview_text)) + { + for (int n = 0; n < IM_ARRAYSIZE(policies); n++) + if (ImGui::Selectable(policies[n].Name, idx == n)) + *p_flags = (*p_flags & ~ImGuiTableFlags_SizingMask_) | policies[n].Value; + ImGui::EndCombo(); + } + ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::TextDisabled("(?)"); + if (ImGui::IsItemHovered()) + { + ImGui::BeginTooltip(); + ImGui::PushTextWrapPos(ImGui::GetFontSize() * 50.0f); + for (int m = 0; m < IM_ARRAYSIZE(policies); m++) + { + ImGui::Separator(); + ImGui::Text("%s:", policies[m].Name); + ImGui::Separator(); + ImGui::SetCursorPosX(ImGui::GetCursorPosX() + ImGui::GetStyle().IndentSpacing * 0.5f); + ImGui::TextUnformatted(policies[m].Tooltip); + } + ImGui::PopTextWrapPos(); + ImGui::EndTooltip(); + } +} + +static void EditTableColumnsFlags(ImGuiTableColumnFlags* p_flags) +{ + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("_Disabled", p_flags, ImGuiTableColumnFlags_Disabled); ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Master disable flag (also hide from context menu)"); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("_DefaultHide", p_flags, ImGuiTableColumnFlags_DefaultHide); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("_DefaultSort", p_flags, ImGuiTableColumnFlags_DefaultSort); + if (ImGui::CheckboxFlags("_WidthStretch", p_flags, ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthStretch)) + *p_flags &= ~(ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthMask_ ^ ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthStretch); + if (ImGui::CheckboxFlags("_WidthFixed", p_flags, ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthFixed)) + *p_flags &= ~(ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthMask_ ^ ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthFixed); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("_NoResize", p_flags, ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoResize); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("_NoReorder", p_flags, ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoReorder); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("_NoHide", p_flags, ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoHide); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("_NoClip", p_flags, ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoClip); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("_NoSort", p_flags, ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoSort); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("_NoSortAscending", p_flags, ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoSortAscending); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("_NoSortDescending", p_flags, ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoSortDescending); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("_NoHeaderLabel", p_flags, ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoHeaderLabel); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("_NoHeaderWidth", p_flags, ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoHeaderWidth); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("_PreferSortAscending", p_flags, ImGuiTableColumnFlags_PreferSortAscending); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("_PreferSortDescending", p_flags, ImGuiTableColumnFlags_PreferSortDescending); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("_IndentEnable", p_flags, ImGuiTableColumnFlags_IndentEnable); ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Default for column 0"); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("_IndentDisable", p_flags, ImGuiTableColumnFlags_IndentDisable); ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Default for column >0"); +} + +static void ShowTableColumnsStatusFlags(ImGuiTableColumnFlags flags) +{ + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("_IsEnabled", &flags, ImGuiTableColumnFlags_IsEnabled); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("_IsVisible", &flags, ImGuiTableColumnFlags_IsVisible); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("_IsSorted", &flags, ImGuiTableColumnFlags_IsSorted); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("_IsHovered", &flags, ImGuiTableColumnFlags_IsHovered); +} + +static void ShowDemoWindowTables() +{ + //ImGui::SetNextItemOpen(true, ImGuiCond_Once); + if (!ImGui::CollapsingHeader("Tables & Columns")) + return; + + // Using those as a base value to create width/height that are factor of the size of our font + const float TEXT_BASE_WIDTH = ImGui::CalcTextSize("A").x; + const float TEXT_BASE_HEIGHT = ImGui::GetTextLineHeightWithSpacing(); + + ImGui::PushID("Tables"); + + int open_action = -1; + if (ImGui::Button("Open all")) + open_action = 1; + ImGui::SameLine(); + if (ImGui::Button("Close all")) + open_action = 0; + ImGui::SameLine(); + + // Options + static bool disable_indent = false; + ImGui::Checkbox("Disable tree indentation", &disable_indent); + ImGui::SameLine(); + HelpMarker("Disable the indenting of tree nodes so demo tables can use the full window width."); + ImGui::Separator(); + if (disable_indent) + ImGui::PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_IndentSpacing, 0.0f); + + // About Styling of tables + // Most settings are configured on a per-table basis via the flags passed to BeginTable() and TableSetupColumns APIs. + // There are however a few settings that a shared and part of the ImGuiStyle structure: + // style.CellPadding // Padding within each cell + // style.Colors[ImGuiCol_TableHeaderBg] // Table header background + // style.Colors[ImGuiCol_TableBorderStrong] // Table outer and header borders + // style.Colors[ImGuiCol_TableBorderLight] // Table inner borders + // style.Colors[ImGuiCol_TableRowBg] // Table row background when ImGuiTableFlags_RowBg is enabled (even rows) + // style.Colors[ImGuiCol_TableRowBgAlt] // Table row background when ImGuiTableFlags_RowBg is enabled (odds rows) + + // Demos + if (open_action != -1) + ImGui::SetNextItemOpen(open_action != 0); + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Basic")) + { + // Here we will showcase three different ways to output a table. + // They are very simple variations of a same thing! + + // [Method 1] Using TableNextRow() to create a new row, and TableSetColumnIndex() to select the column. + // In many situations, this is the most flexible and easy to use pattern. + HelpMarker("Using TableNextRow() + calling TableSetColumnIndex() _before_ each cell, in a loop."); + if (ImGui::BeginTable("table1", 3)) + { + for (int row = 0; row < 4; row++) + { + ImGui::TableNextRow(); + for (int column = 0; column < 3; column++) + { + ImGui::TableSetColumnIndex(column); + ImGui::Text("Row %d Column %d", row, column); + } + } + ImGui::EndTable(); + } + + // [Method 2] Using TableNextColumn() called multiple times, instead of using a for loop + TableSetColumnIndex(). + // This is generally more convenient when you have code manually submitting the contents of each columns. + HelpMarker("Using TableNextRow() + calling TableNextColumn() _before_ each cell, manually."); + if (ImGui::BeginTable("table2", 3)) + { + for (int row = 0; row < 4; row++) + { + ImGui::TableNextRow(); + ImGui::TableNextColumn(); + ImGui::Text("Row %d", row); + ImGui::TableNextColumn(); + ImGui::Text("Some contents"); + ImGui::TableNextColumn(); + ImGui::Text("123.456"); + } + ImGui::EndTable(); + } + + // [Method 3] We call TableNextColumn() _before_ each cell. We never call TableNextRow(), + // as TableNextColumn() will automatically wrap around and create new roes as needed. + // This is generally more convenient when your cells all contains the same type of data. + HelpMarker( + "Only using TableNextColumn(), which tends to be convenient for tables where every cells contains the same type of contents.\n" + "This is also more similar to the old NextColumn() function of the Columns API, and provided to facilitate the Columns->Tables API transition."); + if (ImGui::BeginTable("table3", 3)) + { + for (int item = 0; item < 14; item++) + { + ImGui::TableNextColumn(); + ImGui::Text("Item %d", item); + } + ImGui::EndTable(); + } + + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (open_action != -1) + ImGui::SetNextItemOpen(open_action != 0); + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Borders, background")) + { + // Expose a few Borders related flags interactively + enum ContentsType { CT_Text, CT_FillButton }; + static ImGuiTableFlags flags = ImGuiTableFlags_Borders | ImGuiTableFlags_RowBg; + static bool display_headers = false; + static int contents_type = CT_Text; + + PushStyleCompact(); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_RowBg", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_RowBg); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_Borders", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_Borders); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("ImGuiTableFlags_Borders\n = ImGuiTableFlags_BordersInnerV\n | ImGuiTableFlags_BordersOuterV\n | ImGuiTableFlags_BordersInnerV\n | ImGuiTableFlags_BordersOuterH"); + ImGui::Indent(); + + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_BordersH", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_BordersH); + ImGui::Indent(); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_BordersOuterH", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_BordersOuterH); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_BordersInnerH", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_BordersInnerH); + ImGui::Unindent(); + + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_BordersV", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_BordersV); + ImGui::Indent(); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_BordersOuterV", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_BordersOuterV); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_BordersInnerV", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_BordersInnerV); + ImGui::Unindent(); + + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_BordersOuter", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_BordersOuter); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_BordersInner", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_BordersInner); + ImGui::Unindent(); + + ImGui::AlignTextToFramePadding(); ImGui::Text("Cell contents:"); + ImGui::SameLine(); ImGui::RadioButton("Text", &contents_type, CT_Text); + ImGui::SameLine(); ImGui::RadioButton("FillButton", &contents_type, CT_FillButton); + ImGui::Checkbox("Display headers", &display_headers); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_NoBordersInBody", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_NoBordersInBody); ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Disable vertical borders in columns Body (borders will always appears in Headers"); + PopStyleCompact(); + + if (ImGui::BeginTable("table1", 3, flags)) + { + // Display headers so we can inspect their interaction with borders. + // (Headers are not the main purpose of this section of the demo, so we are not elaborating on them too much. See other sections for details) + if (display_headers) + { + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("One"); + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("Two"); + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("Three"); + ImGui::TableHeadersRow(); + } + + for (int row = 0; row < 5; row++) + { + ImGui::TableNextRow(); + for (int column = 0; column < 3; column++) + { + ImGui::TableSetColumnIndex(column); + char buf[32]; + sprintf(buf, "Hello %d,%d", column, row); + if (contents_type == CT_Text) + ImGui::TextUnformatted(buf); + else if (contents_type) + ImGui::Button(buf, ImVec2(-FLT_MIN, 0.0f)); + } + } + ImGui::EndTable(); + } + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (open_action != -1) + ImGui::SetNextItemOpen(open_action != 0); + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Resizable, stretch")) + { + // By default, if we don't enable ScrollX the sizing policy for each columns is "Stretch" + // Each columns maintain a sizing weight, and they will occupy all available width. + static ImGuiTableFlags flags = ImGuiTableFlags_SizingStretchSame | ImGuiTableFlags_Resizable | ImGuiTableFlags_BordersOuter | ImGuiTableFlags_BordersV | ImGuiTableFlags_ContextMenuInBody; + PushStyleCompact(); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_Resizable", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_Resizable); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_BordersV", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_BordersV); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Using the _Resizable flag automatically enables the _BordersInnerV flag as well, this is why the resize borders are still showing when unchecking this."); + PopStyleCompact(); + + if (ImGui::BeginTable("table1", 3, flags)) + { + for (int row = 0; row < 5; row++) + { + ImGui::TableNextRow(); + for (int column = 0; column < 3; column++) + { + ImGui::TableSetColumnIndex(column); + ImGui::Text("Hello %d,%d", column, row); + } + } + ImGui::EndTable(); + } + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (open_action != -1) + ImGui::SetNextItemOpen(open_action != 0); + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Resizable, fixed")) + { + // Here we use ImGuiTableFlags_SizingFixedFit (even though _ScrollX is not set) + // So columns will adopt the "Fixed" policy and will maintain a fixed width regardless of the whole available width (unless table is small) + // If there is not enough available width to fit all columns, they will however be resized down. + // FIXME-TABLE: Providing a stretch-on-init would make sense especially for tables which don't have saved settings + HelpMarker( + "Using _Resizable + _SizingFixedFit flags.\n" + "Fixed-width columns generally makes more sense if you want to use horizontal scrolling.\n\n" + "Double-click a column border to auto-fit the column to its contents."); + PushStyleCompact(); + static ImGuiTableFlags flags = ImGuiTableFlags_SizingFixedFit | ImGuiTableFlags_Resizable | ImGuiTableFlags_BordersOuter | ImGuiTableFlags_BordersV | ImGuiTableFlags_ContextMenuInBody; + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_NoHostExtendX", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_NoHostExtendX); + PopStyleCompact(); + + if (ImGui::BeginTable("table1", 3, flags)) + { + for (int row = 0; row < 5; row++) + { + ImGui::TableNextRow(); + for (int column = 0; column < 3; column++) + { + ImGui::TableSetColumnIndex(column); + ImGui::Text("Hello %d,%d", column, row); + } + } + ImGui::EndTable(); + } + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (open_action != -1) + ImGui::SetNextItemOpen(open_action != 0); + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Resizable, mixed")) + { + HelpMarker( + "Using TableSetupColumn() to alter resizing policy on a per-column basis.\n\n" + "When combining Fixed and Stretch columns, generally you only want one, maybe two trailing columns to use _WidthStretch."); + static ImGuiTableFlags flags = ImGuiTableFlags_SizingFixedFit | ImGuiTableFlags_RowBg | ImGuiTableFlags_Borders | ImGuiTableFlags_Resizable | ImGuiTableFlags_Reorderable | ImGuiTableFlags_Hideable; + + if (ImGui::BeginTable("table1", 3, flags)) + { + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("AAA", ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthFixed); + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("BBB", ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthFixed); + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("CCC", ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthStretch); + ImGui::TableHeadersRow(); + for (int row = 0; row < 5; row++) + { + ImGui::TableNextRow(); + for (int column = 0; column < 3; column++) + { + ImGui::TableSetColumnIndex(column); + ImGui::Text("%s %d,%d", (column == 2) ? "Stretch" : "Fixed", column, row); + } + } + ImGui::EndTable(); + } + if (ImGui::BeginTable("table2", 6, flags)) + { + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("AAA", ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthFixed); + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("BBB", ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthFixed); + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("CCC", ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthFixed | ImGuiTableColumnFlags_DefaultHide); + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("DDD", ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthStretch); + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("EEE", ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthStretch); + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("FFF", ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthStretch | ImGuiTableColumnFlags_DefaultHide); + ImGui::TableHeadersRow(); + for (int row = 0; row < 5; row++) + { + ImGui::TableNextRow(); + for (int column = 0; column < 6; column++) + { + ImGui::TableSetColumnIndex(column); + ImGui::Text("%s %d,%d", (column >= 3) ? "Stretch" : "Fixed", column, row); + } + } + ImGui::EndTable(); + } + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (open_action != -1) + ImGui::SetNextItemOpen(open_action != 0); + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Reorderable, hideable, with headers")) + { + HelpMarker( + "Click and drag column headers to reorder columns.\n\n" + "Right-click on a header to open a context menu."); + static ImGuiTableFlags flags = ImGuiTableFlags_Resizable | ImGuiTableFlags_Reorderable | ImGuiTableFlags_Hideable | ImGuiTableFlags_BordersOuter | ImGuiTableFlags_BordersV; + PushStyleCompact(); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_Resizable", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_Resizable); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_Reorderable", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_Reorderable); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_Hideable", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_Hideable); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_NoBordersInBody", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_NoBordersInBody); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_NoBordersInBodyUntilResize", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_NoBordersInBodyUntilResize); ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Disable vertical borders in columns Body until hovered for resize (borders will always appears in Headers)"); + PopStyleCompact(); + + if (ImGui::BeginTable("table1", 3, flags)) + { + // Submit columns name with TableSetupColumn() and call TableHeadersRow() to create a row with a header in each column. + // (Later we will show how TableSetupColumn() has other uses, optional flags, sizing weight etc.) + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("One"); + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("Two"); + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("Three"); + ImGui::TableHeadersRow(); + for (int row = 0; row < 6; row++) + { + ImGui::TableNextRow(); + for (int column = 0; column < 3; column++) + { + ImGui::TableSetColumnIndex(column); + ImGui::Text("Hello %d,%d", column, row); + } + } + ImGui::EndTable(); + } + + // Use outer_size.x == 0.0f instead of default to make the table as tight as possible (only valid when no scrolling and no stretch column) + if (ImGui::BeginTable("table2", 3, flags | ImGuiTableFlags_SizingFixedFit, ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f))) + { + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("One"); + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("Two"); + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("Three"); + ImGui::TableHeadersRow(); + for (int row = 0; row < 6; row++) + { + ImGui::TableNextRow(); + for (int column = 0; column < 3; column++) + { + ImGui::TableSetColumnIndex(column); + ImGui::Text("Fixed %d,%d", column, row); + } + } + ImGui::EndTable(); + } + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (open_action != -1) + ImGui::SetNextItemOpen(open_action != 0); + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Padding")) + { + // First example: showcase use of padding flags and effect of BorderOuterV/BorderInnerV on X padding. + // We don't expose BorderOuterH/BorderInnerH here because they have no effect on X padding. + HelpMarker( + "We often want outer padding activated when any using features which makes the edges of a column visible:\n" + "e.g.:\n" + "- BorderOuterV\n" + "- any form of row selection\n" + "Because of this, activating BorderOuterV sets the default to PadOuterX. Using PadOuterX or NoPadOuterX you can override the default.\n\n" + "Actual padding values are using style.CellPadding.\n\n" + "In this demo we don't show horizontal borders to emphasis how they don't affect default horizontal padding."); + + static ImGuiTableFlags flags1 = ImGuiTableFlags_BordersV; + PushStyleCompact(); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_PadOuterX", &flags1, ImGuiTableFlags_PadOuterX); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Enable outer-most padding (default if ImGuiTableFlags_BordersOuterV is set)"); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_NoPadOuterX", &flags1, ImGuiTableFlags_NoPadOuterX); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Disable outer-most padding (default if ImGuiTableFlags_BordersOuterV is not set)"); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_NoPadInnerX", &flags1, ImGuiTableFlags_NoPadInnerX); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Disable inner padding between columns (double inner padding if BordersOuterV is on, single inner padding if BordersOuterV is off)"); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_BordersOuterV", &flags1, ImGuiTableFlags_BordersOuterV); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_BordersInnerV", &flags1, ImGuiTableFlags_BordersInnerV); + static bool show_headers = false; + ImGui::Checkbox("show_headers", &show_headers); + PopStyleCompact(); + + if (ImGui::BeginTable("table_padding", 3, flags1)) + { + if (show_headers) + { + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("One"); + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("Two"); + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("Three"); + ImGui::TableHeadersRow(); + } + + for (int row = 0; row < 5; row++) + { + ImGui::TableNextRow(); + for (int column = 0; column < 3; column++) + { + ImGui::TableSetColumnIndex(column); + if (row == 0) + { + ImGui::Text("Avail %.2f", ImGui::GetContentRegionAvail().x); + } + else + { + char buf[32]; + sprintf(buf, "Hello %d,%d", column, row); + ImGui::Button(buf, ImVec2(-FLT_MIN, 0.0f)); + } + //if (ImGui::TableGetColumnFlags() & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_IsHovered) + // ImGui::TableSetBgColor(ImGuiTableBgTarget_CellBg, IM_COL32(0, 100, 0, 255)); + } + } + ImGui::EndTable(); + } + + // Second example: set style.CellPadding to (0.0) or a custom value. + // FIXME-TABLE: Vertical border effectively not displayed the same way as horizontal one... + HelpMarker("Setting style.CellPadding to (0,0) or a custom value."); + static ImGuiTableFlags flags2 = ImGuiTableFlags_Borders | ImGuiTableFlags_RowBg; + static ImVec2 cell_padding(0.0f, 0.0f); + static bool show_widget_frame_bg = true; + + PushStyleCompact(); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_Borders", &flags2, ImGuiTableFlags_Borders); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_BordersH", &flags2, ImGuiTableFlags_BordersH); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_BordersV", &flags2, ImGuiTableFlags_BordersV); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_BordersInner", &flags2, ImGuiTableFlags_BordersInner); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_BordersOuter", &flags2, ImGuiTableFlags_BordersOuter); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_RowBg", &flags2, ImGuiTableFlags_RowBg); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_Resizable", &flags2, ImGuiTableFlags_Resizable); + ImGui::Checkbox("show_widget_frame_bg", &show_widget_frame_bg); + ImGui::SliderFloat2("CellPadding", &cell_padding.x, 0.0f, 10.0f, "%.0f"); + PopStyleCompact(); + + ImGui::PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_CellPadding, cell_padding); + if (ImGui::BeginTable("table_padding_2", 3, flags2)) + { + static char text_bufs[3 * 5][16]; // Mini text storage for 3x5 cells + static bool init = true; + if (!show_widget_frame_bg) + ImGui::PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_FrameBg, 0); + for (int cell = 0; cell < 3 * 5; cell++) + { + ImGui::TableNextColumn(); + if (init) + strcpy(text_bufs[cell], "edit me"); + ImGui::SetNextItemWidth(-FLT_MIN); + ImGui::PushID(cell); + ImGui::InputText("##cell", text_bufs[cell], IM_ARRAYSIZE(text_bufs[cell])); + ImGui::PopID(); + } + if (!show_widget_frame_bg) + ImGui::PopStyleColor(); + init = false; + ImGui::EndTable(); + } + ImGui::PopStyleVar(); + + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (open_action != -1) + ImGui::SetNextItemOpen(open_action != 0); + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Sizing policies")) + { + static ImGuiTableFlags flags1 = ImGuiTableFlags_BordersV | ImGuiTableFlags_BordersOuterH | ImGuiTableFlags_RowBg | ImGuiTableFlags_ContextMenuInBody; + PushStyleCompact(); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_Resizable", &flags1, ImGuiTableFlags_Resizable); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_NoHostExtendX", &flags1, ImGuiTableFlags_NoHostExtendX); + PopStyleCompact(); + + static ImGuiTableFlags sizing_policy_flags[4] = { ImGuiTableFlags_SizingFixedFit, ImGuiTableFlags_SizingFixedSame, ImGuiTableFlags_SizingStretchProp, ImGuiTableFlags_SizingStretchSame }; + for (int table_n = 0; table_n < 4; table_n++) + { + ImGui::PushID(table_n); + ImGui::SetNextItemWidth(TEXT_BASE_WIDTH * 30); + EditTableSizingFlags(&sizing_policy_flags[table_n]); + + // To make it easier to understand the different sizing policy, + // For each policy: we display one table where the columns have equal contents width, and one where the columns have different contents width. + if (ImGui::BeginTable("table1", 3, sizing_policy_flags[table_n] | flags1)) + { + for (int row = 0; row < 3; row++) + { + ImGui::TableNextRow(); + ImGui::TableNextColumn(); ImGui::Text("Oh dear"); + ImGui::TableNextColumn(); ImGui::Text("Oh dear"); + ImGui::TableNextColumn(); ImGui::Text("Oh dear"); + } + ImGui::EndTable(); + } + if (ImGui::BeginTable("table2", 3, sizing_policy_flags[table_n] | flags1)) + { + for (int row = 0; row < 3; row++) + { + ImGui::TableNextRow(); + ImGui::TableNextColumn(); ImGui::Text("AAAA"); + ImGui::TableNextColumn(); ImGui::Text("BBBBBBBB"); + ImGui::TableNextColumn(); ImGui::Text("CCCCCCCCCCCC"); + } + ImGui::EndTable(); + } + ImGui::PopID(); + } + + ImGui::Spacing(); + ImGui::TextUnformatted("Advanced"); + ImGui::SameLine(); + HelpMarker("This section allows you to interact and see the effect of various sizing policies depending on whether Scroll is enabled and the contents of your columns."); + + enum ContentsType { CT_ShowWidth, CT_ShortText, CT_LongText, CT_Button, CT_FillButton, CT_InputText }; + static ImGuiTableFlags flags = ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollY | ImGuiTableFlags_Borders | ImGuiTableFlags_RowBg | ImGuiTableFlags_Resizable; + static int contents_type = CT_ShowWidth; + static int column_count = 3; + + PushStyleCompact(); + ImGui::PushID("Advanced"); + ImGui::PushItemWidth(TEXT_BASE_WIDTH * 30); + EditTableSizingFlags(&flags); + ImGui::Combo("Contents", &contents_type, "Show width\0Short Text\0Long Text\0Button\0Fill Button\0InputText\0"); + if (contents_type == CT_FillButton) + { + ImGui::SameLine(); + HelpMarker("Be mindful that using right-alignment (e.g. size.x = -FLT_MIN) creates a feedback loop where contents width can feed into auto-column width can feed into contents width."); + } + ImGui::DragInt("Columns", &column_count, 0.1f, 1, 64, "%d", ImGuiSliderFlags_AlwaysClamp); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_Resizable", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_Resizable); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_PreciseWidths", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_PreciseWidths); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Disable distributing remainder width to stretched columns (width allocation on a 100-wide table with 3 columns: Without this flag: 33,33,34. With this flag: 33,33,33). With larger number of columns, resizing will appear to be less smooth."); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollX", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollX); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollY", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollY); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_NoClip", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_NoClip); + ImGui::PopItemWidth(); + ImGui::PopID(); + PopStyleCompact(); + + if (ImGui::BeginTable("table2", column_count, flags, ImVec2(0.0f, TEXT_BASE_HEIGHT * 7))) + { + for (int cell = 0; cell < 10 * column_count; cell++) + { + ImGui::TableNextColumn(); + int column = ImGui::TableGetColumnIndex(); + int row = ImGui::TableGetRowIndex(); + + ImGui::PushID(cell); + char label[32]; + static char text_buf[32] = ""; + sprintf(label, "Hello %d,%d", column, row); + switch (contents_type) + { + case CT_ShortText: ImGui::TextUnformatted(label); break; + case CT_LongText: ImGui::Text("Some %s text %d,%d\nOver two lines..", column == 0 ? "long" : "longeeer", column, row); break; + case CT_ShowWidth: ImGui::Text("W: %.1f", ImGui::GetContentRegionAvail().x); break; + case CT_Button: ImGui::Button(label); break; + case CT_FillButton: ImGui::Button(label, ImVec2(-FLT_MIN, 0.0f)); break; + case CT_InputText: ImGui::SetNextItemWidth(-FLT_MIN); ImGui::InputText("##", text_buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(text_buf)); break; + } + ImGui::PopID(); + } + ImGui::EndTable(); + } + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (open_action != -1) + ImGui::SetNextItemOpen(open_action != 0); + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Vertical scrolling, with clipping")) + { + HelpMarker("Here we activate ScrollY, which will create a child window container to allow hosting scrollable contents.\n\nWe also demonstrate using ImGuiListClipper to virtualize the submission of many items."); + static ImGuiTableFlags flags = ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollY | ImGuiTableFlags_RowBg | ImGuiTableFlags_BordersOuter | ImGuiTableFlags_BordersV | ImGuiTableFlags_Resizable | ImGuiTableFlags_Reorderable | ImGuiTableFlags_Hideable; + + PushStyleCompact(); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollY", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollY); + PopStyleCompact(); + + // When using ScrollX or ScrollY we need to specify a size for our table container! + // Otherwise by default the table will fit all available space, like a BeginChild() call. + ImVec2 outer_size = ImVec2(0.0f, TEXT_BASE_HEIGHT * 8); + if (ImGui::BeginTable("table_scrolly", 3, flags, outer_size)) + { + ImGui::TableSetupScrollFreeze(0, 1); // Make top row always visible + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("One", ImGuiTableColumnFlags_None); + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("Two", ImGuiTableColumnFlags_None); + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("Three", ImGuiTableColumnFlags_None); + ImGui::TableHeadersRow(); + + // Demonstrate using clipper for large vertical lists + ImGuiListClipper clipper; + clipper.Begin(1000); + while (clipper.Step()) + { + for (int row = clipper.DisplayStart; row < clipper.DisplayEnd; row++) + { + ImGui::TableNextRow(); + for (int column = 0; column < 3; column++) + { + ImGui::TableSetColumnIndex(column); + ImGui::Text("Hello %d,%d", column, row); + } + } + } + ImGui::EndTable(); + } + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (open_action != -1) + ImGui::SetNextItemOpen(open_action != 0); + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Horizontal scrolling")) + { + HelpMarker( + "When ScrollX is enabled, the default sizing policy becomes ImGuiTableFlags_SizingFixedFit, " + "as automatically stretching columns doesn't make much sense with horizontal scrolling.\n\n" + "Also note that as of the current version, you will almost always want to enable ScrollY along with ScrollX," + "because the container window won't automatically extend vertically to fix contents (this may be improved in future versions)."); + static ImGuiTableFlags flags = ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollX | ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollY | ImGuiTableFlags_RowBg | ImGuiTableFlags_BordersOuter | ImGuiTableFlags_BordersV | ImGuiTableFlags_Resizable | ImGuiTableFlags_Reorderable | ImGuiTableFlags_Hideable; + static int freeze_cols = 1; + static int freeze_rows = 1; + + PushStyleCompact(); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_Resizable", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_Resizable); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollX", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollX); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollY", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollY); + ImGui::SetNextItemWidth(ImGui::GetFrameHeight()); + ImGui::DragInt("freeze_cols", &freeze_cols, 0.2f, 0, 9, NULL, ImGuiSliderFlags_NoInput); + ImGui::SetNextItemWidth(ImGui::GetFrameHeight()); + ImGui::DragInt("freeze_rows", &freeze_rows, 0.2f, 0, 9, NULL, ImGuiSliderFlags_NoInput); + PopStyleCompact(); + + // When using ScrollX or ScrollY we need to specify a size for our table container! + // Otherwise by default the table will fit all available space, like a BeginChild() call. + ImVec2 outer_size = ImVec2(0.0f, TEXT_BASE_HEIGHT * 8); + if (ImGui::BeginTable("table_scrollx", 7, flags, outer_size)) + { + ImGui::TableSetupScrollFreeze(freeze_cols, freeze_rows); + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("Line #", ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoHide); // Make the first column not hideable to match our use of TableSetupScrollFreeze() + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("One"); + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("Two"); + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("Three"); + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("Four"); + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("Five"); + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("Six"); + ImGui::TableHeadersRow(); + for (int row = 0; row < 20; row++) + { + ImGui::TableNextRow(); + for (int column = 0; column < 7; column++) + { + // Both TableNextColumn() and TableSetColumnIndex() return true when a column is visible or performing width measurement. + // Because here we know that: + // - A) all our columns are contributing the same to row height + // - B) column 0 is always visible, + // We only always submit this one column and can skip others. + // More advanced per-column clipping behaviors may benefit from polling the status flags via TableGetColumnFlags(). + if (!ImGui::TableSetColumnIndex(column) && column > 0) + continue; + if (column == 0) + ImGui::Text("Line %d", row); + else + ImGui::Text("Hello world %d,%d", column, row); + } + } + ImGui::EndTable(); + } + + ImGui::Spacing(); + ImGui::TextUnformatted("Stretch + ScrollX"); + ImGui::SameLine(); + HelpMarker( + "Showcase using Stretch columns + ScrollX together: " + "this is rather unusual and only makes sense when specifying an 'inner_width' for the table!\n" + "Without an explicit value, inner_width is == outer_size.x and therefore using Stretch columns + ScrollX together doesn't make sense."); + static ImGuiTableFlags flags2 = ImGuiTableFlags_SizingStretchSame | ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollX | ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollY | ImGuiTableFlags_BordersOuter | ImGuiTableFlags_RowBg | ImGuiTableFlags_ContextMenuInBody; + static float inner_width = 1000.0f; + PushStyleCompact(); + ImGui::PushID("flags3"); + ImGui::PushItemWidth(TEXT_BASE_WIDTH * 30); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollX", &flags2, ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollX); + ImGui::DragFloat("inner_width", &inner_width, 1.0f, 0.0f, FLT_MAX, "%.1f"); + ImGui::PopItemWidth(); + ImGui::PopID(); + PopStyleCompact(); + if (ImGui::BeginTable("table2", 7, flags2, outer_size, inner_width)) + { + for (int cell = 0; cell < 20 * 7; cell++) + { + ImGui::TableNextColumn(); + ImGui::Text("Hello world %d,%d", ImGui::TableGetColumnIndex(), ImGui::TableGetRowIndex()); + } + ImGui::EndTable(); + } + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (open_action != -1) + ImGui::SetNextItemOpen(open_action != 0); + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Columns flags")) + { + // Create a first table just to show all the options/flags we want to make visible in our example! + const int column_count = 3; + const char* column_names[column_count] = { "One", "Two", "Three" }; + static ImGuiTableColumnFlags column_flags[column_count] = { ImGuiTableColumnFlags_DefaultSort, ImGuiTableColumnFlags_None, ImGuiTableColumnFlags_DefaultHide }; + static ImGuiTableColumnFlags column_flags_out[column_count] = { 0, 0, 0 }; // Output from TableGetColumnFlags() + + if (ImGui::BeginTable("table_columns_flags_checkboxes", column_count, ImGuiTableFlags_None)) + { + PushStyleCompact(); + for (int column = 0; column < column_count; column++) + { + ImGui::TableNextColumn(); + ImGui::PushID(column); + ImGui::AlignTextToFramePadding(); // FIXME-TABLE: Workaround for wrong text baseline propagation + ImGui::Text("'%s'", column_names[column]); + ImGui::Spacing(); + ImGui::Text("Input flags:"); + EditTableColumnsFlags(&column_flags[column]); + ImGui::Spacing(); + ImGui::Text("Output flags:"); + ShowTableColumnsStatusFlags(column_flags_out[column]); + ImGui::PopID(); + } + PopStyleCompact(); + ImGui::EndTable(); + } + + // Create the real table we care about for the example! + // We use a scrolling table to be able to showcase the difference between the _IsEnabled and _IsVisible flags above, otherwise in + // a non-scrolling table columns are always visible (unless using ImGuiTableFlags_NoKeepColumnsVisible + resizing the parent window down) + const ImGuiTableFlags flags + = ImGuiTableFlags_SizingFixedFit | ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollX | ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollY + | ImGuiTableFlags_RowBg | ImGuiTableFlags_BordersOuter | ImGuiTableFlags_BordersV + | ImGuiTableFlags_Resizable | ImGuiTableFlags_Reorderable | ImGuiTableFlags_Hideable | ImGuiTableFlags_Sortable; + ImVec2 outer_size = ImVec2(0.0f, TEXT_BASE_HEIGHT * 9); + if (ImGui::BeginTable("table_columns_flags", column_count, flags, outer_size)) + { + for (int column = 0; column < column_count; column++) + ImGui::TableSetupColumn(column_names[column], column_flags[column]); + ImGui::TableHeadersRow(); + for (int column = 0; column < column_count; column++) + column_flags_out[column] = ImGui::TableGetColumnFlags(column); + float indent_step = (float)((int)TEXT_BASE_WIDTH / 2); + for (int row = 0; row < 8; row++) + { + ImGui::Indent(indent_step); // Add some indentation to demonstrate usage of per-column IndentEnable/IndentDisable flags. + ImGui::TableNextRow(); + for (int column = 0; column < column_count; column++) + { + ImGui::TableSetColumnIndex(column); + ImGui::Text("%s %s", (column == 0) ? "Indented" : "Hello", ImGui::TableGetColumnName(column)); + } + } + ImGui::Unindent(indent_step * 8.0f); + + ImGui::EndTable(); + } + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (open_action != -1) + ImGui::SetNextItemOpen(open_action != 0); + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Columns widths")) + { + HelpMarker("Using TableSetupColumn() to setup default width."); + + static ImGuiTableFlags flags1 = ImGuiTableFlags_Borders | ImGuiTableFlags_NoBordersInBodyUntilResize; + PushStyleCompact(); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_Resizable", &flags1, ImGuiTableFlags_Resizable); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_NoBordersInBodyUntilResize", &flags1, ImGuiTableFlags_NoBordersInBodyUntilResize); + PopStyleCompact(); + if (ImGui::BeginTable("table1", 3, flags1)) + { + // We could also set ImGuiTableFlags_SizingFixedFit on the table and all columns will default to ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthFixed. + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("one", ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthFixed, 100.0f); // Default to 100.0f + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("two", ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthFixed, 200.0f); // Default to 200.0f + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("three", ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthFixed); // Default to auto + ImGui::TableHeadersRow(); + for (int row = 0; row < 4; row++) + { + ImGui::TableNextRow(); + for (int column = 0; column < 3; column++) + { + ImGui::TableSetColumnIndex(column); + if (row == 0) + ImGui::Text("(w: %5.1f)", ImGui::GetContentRegionAvail().x); + else + ImGui::Text("Hello %d,%d", column, row); + } + } + ImGui::EndTable(); + } + + HelpMarker("Using TableSetupColumn() to setup explicit width.\n\nUnless _NoKeepColumnsVisible is set, fixed columns with set width may still be shrunk down if there's not enough space in the host."); + + static ImGuiTableFlags flags2 = ImGuiTableFlags_None; + PushStyleCompact(); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_NoKeepColumnsVisible", &flags2, ImGuiTableFlags_NoKeepColumnsVisible); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_BordersInnerV", &flags2, ImGuiTableFlags_BordersInnerV); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_BordersOuterV", &flags2, ImGuiTableFlags_BordersOuterV); + PopStyleCompact(); + if (ImGui::BeginTable("table2", 4, flags2)) + { + // We could also set ImGuiTableFlags_SizingFixedFit on the table and all columns will default to ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthFixed. + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("", ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthFixed, 100.0f); + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("", ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthFixed, TEXT_BASE_WIDTH * 15.0f); + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("", ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthFixed, TEXT_BASE_WIDTH * 30.0f); + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("", ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthFixed, TEXT_BASE_WIDTH * 15.0f); + for (int row = 0; row < 5; row++) + { + ImGui::TableNextRow(); + for (int column = 0; column < 4; column++) + { + ImGui::TableSetColumnIndex(column); + if (row == 0) + ImGui::Text("(w: %5.1f)", ImGui::GetContentRegionAvail().x); + else + ImGui::Text("Hello %d,%d", column, row); + } + } + ImGui::EndTable(); + } + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (open_action != -1) + ImGui::SetNextItemOpen(open_action != 0); + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Nested tables")) + { + HelpMarker("This demonstrate embedding a table into another table cell."); + + if (ImGui::BeginTable("table_nested1", 2, ImGuiTableFlags_Borders | ImGuiTableFlags_Resizable | ImGuiTableFlags_Reorderable | ImGuiTableFlags_Hideable)) + { + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("A0"); + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("A1"); + ImGui::TableHeadersRow(); + + ImGui::TableNextColumn(); + ImGui::Text("A0 Row 0"); + { + float rows_height = TEXT_BASE_HEIGHT * 2; + if (ImGui::BeginTable("table_nested2", 2, ImGuiTableFlags_Borders | ImGuiTableFlags_Resizable | ImGuiTableFlags_Reorderable | ImGuiTableFlags_Hideable)) + { + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("B0"); + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("B1"); + ImGui::TableHeadersRow(); + + ImGui::TableNextRow(ImGuiTableRowFlags_None, rows_height); + ImGui::TableNextColumn(); + ImGui::Text("B0 Row 0"); + ImGui::TableNextColumn(); + ImGui::Text("B1 Row 0"); + ImGui::TableNextRow(ImGuiTableRowFlags_None, rows_height); + ImGui::TableNextColumn(); + ImGui::Text("B0 Row 1"); + ImGui::TableNextColumn(); + ImGui::Text("B1 Row 1"); + + ImGui::EndTable(); + } + } + ImGui::TableNextColumn(); ImGui::Text("A1 Row 0"); + ImGui::TableNextColumn(); ImGui::Text("A0 Row 1"); + ImGui::TableNextColumn(); ImGui::Text("A1 Row 1"); + ImGui::EndTable(); + } + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (open_action != -1) + ImGui::SetNextItemOpen(open_action != 0); + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Row height")) + { + HelpMarker("You can pass a 'min_row_height' to TableNextRow().\n\nRows are padded with 'style.CellPadding.y' on top and bottom, so effectively the minimum row height will always be >= 'style.CellPadding.y * 2.0f'.\n\nWe cannot honor a _maximum_ row height as that would requires a unique clipping rectangle per row."); + if (ImGui::BeginTable("table_row_height", 1, ImGuiTableFlags_BordersOuter | ImGuiTableFlags_BordersInnerV)) + { + for (int row = 0; row < 10; row++) + { + float min_row_height = (float)(int)(TEXT_BASE_HEIGHT * 0.30f * row); + ImGui::TableNextRow(ImGuiTableRowFlags_None, min_row_height); + ImGui::TableNextColumn(); + ImGui::Text("min_row_height = %.2f", min_row_height); + } + ImGui::EndTable(); + } + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (open_action != -1) + ImGui::SetNextItemOpen(open_action != 0); + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Outer size")) + { + // Showcasing use of ImGuiTableFlags_NoHostExtendX and ImGuiTableFlags_NoHostExtendY + // Important to that note how the two flags have slightly different behaviors! + ImGui::Text("Using NoHostExtendX and NoHostExtendY:"); + PushStyleCompact(); + static ImGuiTableFlags flags = ImGuiTableFlags_Borders | ImGuiTableFlags_Resizable | ImGuiTableFlags_ContextMenuInBody | ImGuiTableFlags_RowBg | ImGuiTableFlags_SizingFixedFit | ImGuiTableFlags_NoHostExtendX; + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_NoHostExtendX", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_NoHostExtendX); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Make outer width auto-fit to columns, overriding outer_size.x value.\n\nOnly available when ScrollX/ScrollY are disabled and Stretch columns are not used."); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_NoHostExtendY", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_NoHostExtendY); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Make outer height stop exactly at outer_size.y (prevent auto-extending table past the limit).\n\nOnly available when ScrollX/ScrollY are disabled. Data below the limit will be clipped and not visible."); + PopStyleCompact(); + + ImVec2 outer_size = ImVec2(0.0f, TEXT_BASE_HEIGHT * 5.5f); + if (ImGui::BeginTable("table1", 3, flags, outer_size)) + { + for (int row = 0; row < 10; row++) + { + ImGui::TableNextRow(); + for (int column = 0; column < 3; column++) + { + ImGui::TableNextColumn(); + ImGui::Text("Cell %d,%d", column, row); + } + } + ImGui::EndTable(); + } + ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::Text("Hello!"); + + ImGui::Spacing(); + + ImGui::Text("Using explicit size:"); + if (ImGui::BeginTable("table2", 3, ImGuiTableFlags_Borders | ImGuiTableFlags_RowBg, ImVec2(TEXT_BASE_WIDTH * 30, 0.0f))) + { + for (int row = 0; row < 5; row++) + { + ImGui::TableNextRow(); + for (int column = 0; column < 3; column++) + { + ImGui::TableNextColumn(); + ImGui::Text("Cell %d,%d", column, row); + } + } + ImGui::EndTable(); + } + ImGui::SameLine(); + if (ImGui::BeginTable("table3", 3, ImGuiTableFlags_Borders | ImGuiTableFlags_RowBg, ImVec2(TEXT_BASE_WIDTH * 30, 0.0f))) + { + for (int row = 0; row < 3; row++) + { + ImGui::TableNextRow(0, TEXT_BASE_HEIGHT * 1.5f); + for (int column = 0; column < 3; column++) + { + ImGui::TableNextColumn(); + ImGui::Text("Cell %d,%d", column, row); + } + } + ImGui::EndTable(); + } + + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (open_action != -1) + ImGui::SetNextItemOpen(open_action != 0); + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Background color")) + { + static ImGuiTableFlags flags = ImGuiTableFlags_RowBg; + static int row_bg_type = 1; + static int row_bg_target = 1; + static int cell_bg_type = 1; + + PushStyleCompact(); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_Borders", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_Borders); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_RowBg", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_RowBg); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("ImGuiTableFlags_RowBg automatically sets RowBg0 to alternative colors pulled from the Style."); + ImGui::Combo("row bg type", (int*)&row_bg_type, "None\0Red\0Gradient\0"); + ImGui::Combo("row bg target", (int*)&row_bg_target, "RowBg0\0RowBg1\0"); ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Target RowBg0 to override the alternating odd/even colors,\nTarget RowBg1 to blend with them."); + ImGui::Combo("cell bg type", (int*)&cell_bg_type, "None\0Blue\0"); ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("We are colorizing cells to B1->C2 here."); + IM_ASSERT(row_bg_type >= 0 && row_bg_type <= 2); + IM_ASSERT(row_bg_target >= 0 && row_bg_target <= 1); + IM_ASSERT(cell_bg_type >= 0 && cell_bg_type <= 1); + PopStyleCompact(); + + if (ImGui::BeginTable("table1", 5, flags)) + { + for (int row = 0; row < 6; row++) + { + ImGui::TableNextRow(); + + // Demonstrate setting a row background color with 'ImGui::TableSetBgColor(ImGuiTableBgTarget_RowBgX, ...)' + // We use a transparent color so we can see the one behind in case our target is RowBg1 and RowBg0 was already targeted by the ImGuiTableFlags_RowBg flag. + if (row_bg_type != 0) + { + ImU32 row_bg_color = ImGui::GetColorU32(row_bg_type == 1 ? ImVec4(0.7f, 0.3f, 0.3f, 0.65f) : ImVec4(0.2f + row * 0.1f, 0.2f, 0.2f, 0.65f)); // Flat or Gradient? + ImGui::TableSetBgColor(ImGuiTableBgTarget_RowBg0 + row_bg_target, row_bg_color); + } + + // Fill cells + for (int column = 0; column < 5; column++) + { + ImGui::TableSetColumnIndex(column); + ImGui::Text("%c%c", 'A' + row, '0' + column); + + // Change background of Cells B1->C2 + // Demonstrate setting a cell background color with 'ImGui::TableSetBgColor(ImGuiTableBgTarget_CellBg, ...)' + // (the CellBg color will be blended over the RowBg and ColumnBg colors) + // We can also pass a column number as a third parameter to TableSetBgColor() and do this outside the column loop. + if (row >= 1 && row <= 2 && column >= 1 && column <= 2 && cell_bg_type == 1) + { + ImU32 cell_bg_color = ImGui::GetColorU32(ImVec4(0.3f, 0.3f, 0.7f, 0.65f)); + ImGui::TableSetBgColor(ImGuiTableBgTarget_CellBg, cell_bg_color); + } + } + } + ImGui::EndTable(); + } + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (open_action != -1) + ImGui::SetNextItemOpen(open_action != 0); + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Tree view")) + { + static ImGuiTableFlags flags = ImGuiTableFlags_BordersV | ImGuiTableFlags_BordersOuterH | ImGuiTableFlags_Resizable | ImGuiTableFlags_RowBg | ImGuiTableFlags_NoBordersInBody; + + if (ImGui::BeginTable("3ways", 3, flags)) + { + // The first column will use the default _WidthStretch when ScrollX is Off and _WidthFixed when ScrollX is On + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("Name", ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoHide); + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("Size", ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthFixed, TEXT_BASE_WIDTH * 12.0f); + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("Type", ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthFixed, TEXT_BASE_WIDTH * 18.0f); + ImGui::TableHeadersRow(); + + // Simple storage to output a dummy file-system. + struct MyTreeNode + { + const char* Name; + const char* Type; + int Size; + int ChildIdx; + int ChildCount; + static void DisplayNode(const MyTreeNode* node, const MyTreeNode* all_nodes) + { + ImGui::TableNextRow(); + ImGui::TableNextColumn(); + const bool is_folder = (node->ChildCount > 0); + if (is_folder) + { + bool open = ImGui::TreeNodeEx(node->Name, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_SpanFullWidth); + ImGui::TableNextColumn(); + ImGui::TextDisabled("--"); + ImGui::TableNextColumn(); + ImGui::TextUnformatted(node->Type); + if (open) + { + for (int child_n = 0; child_n < node->ChildCount; child_n++) + DisplayNode(&all_nodes[node->ChildIdx + child_n], all_nodes); + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + } + else + { + ImGui::TreeNodeEx(node->Name, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Leaf | ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Bullet | ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NoTreePushOnOpen | ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_SpanFullWidth); + ImGui::TableNextColumn(); + ImGui::Text("%d", node->Size); + ImGui::TableNextColumn(); + ImGui::TextUnformatted(node->Type); + } + } + }; + static const MyTreeNode nodes[] = + { + { "Root", "Folder", -1, 1, 3 }, // 0 + { "Music", "Folder", -1, 4, 2 }, // 1 + { "Textures", "Folder", -1, 6, 3 }, // 2 + { "desktop.ini", "System file", 1024, -1,-1 }, // 3 + { "File1_a.wav", "Audio file", 123000, -1,-1 }, // 4 + { "File1_b.wav", "Audio file", 456000, -1,-1 }, // 5 + { "Image001.png", "Image file", 203128, -1,-1 }, // 6 + { "Copy of Image001.png", "Image file", 203256, -1,-1 }, // 7 + { "Copy of Image001 (Final2).png","Image file", 203512, -1,-1 }, // 8 + }; + + MyTreeNode::DisplayNode(&nodes[0], nodes); + + ImGui::EndTable(); + } + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (open_action != -1) + ImGui::SetNextItemOpen(open_action != 0); + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Item width")) + { + HelpMarker( + "Showcase using PushItemWidth() and how it is preserved on a per-column basis.\n\n" + "Note that on auto-resizing non-resizable fixed columns, querying the content width for e.g. right-alignment doesn't make sense."); + if (ImGui::BeginTable("table_item_width", 3, ImGuiTableFlags_Borders)) + { + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("small"); + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("half"); + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("right-align"); + ImGui::TableHeadersRow(); + + for (int row = 0; row < 3; row++) + { + ImGui::TableNextRow(); + if (row == 0) + { + // Setup ItemWidth once (instead of setting up every time, which is also possible but less efficient) + ImGui::TableSetColumnIndex(0); + ImGui::PushItemWidth(TEXT_BASE_WIDTH * 3.0f); // Small + ImGui::TableSetColumnIndex(1); + ImGui::PushItemWidth(-ImGui::GetContentRegionAvail().x * 0.5f); + ImGui::TableSetColumnIndex(2); + ImGui::PushItemWidth(-FLT_MIN); // Right-aligned + } + + // Draw our contents + static float dummy_f = 0.0f; + ImGui::PushID(row); + ImGui::TableSetColumnIndex(0); + ImGui::SliderFloat("float0", &dummy_f, 0.0f, 1.0f); + ImGui::TableSetColumnIndex(1); + ImGui::SliderFloat("float1", &dummy_f, 0.0f, 1.0f); + ImGui::TableSetColumnIndex(2); + ImGui::SliderFloat("float2", &dummy_f, 0.0f, 1.0f); + ImGui::PopID(); + } + ImGui::EndTable(); + } + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + // Demonstrate using TableHeader() calls instead of TableHeadersRow() + if (open_action != -1) + ImGui::SetNextItemOpen(open_action != 0); + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Custom headers")) + { + const int COLUMNS_COUNT = 3; + if (ImGui::BeginTable("table_custom_headers", COLUMNS_COUNT, ImGuiTableFlags_Borders | ImGuiTableFlags_Reorderable | ImGuiTableFlags_Hideable)) + { + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("Apricot"); + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("Banana"); + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("Cherry"); + + // Dummy entire-column selection storage + // FIXME: It would be nice to actually demonstrate full-featured selection using those checkbox. + static bool column_selected[3] = {}; + + // Instead of calling TableHeadersRow() we'll submit custom headers ourselves + ImGui::TableNextRow(ImGuiTableRowFlags_Headers); + for (int column = 0; column < COLUMNS_COUNT; column++) + { + ImGui::TableSetColumnIndex(column); + const char* column_name = ImGui::TableGetColumnName(column); // Retrieve name passed to TableSetupColumn() + ImGui::PushID(column); + ImGui::PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_FramePadding, ImVec2(0, 0)); + ImGui::Checkbox("##checkall", &column_selected[column]); + ImGui::PopStyleVar(); + ImGui::SameLine(0.0f, ImGui::GetStyle().ItemInnerSpacing.x); + ImGui::TableHeader(column_name); + ImGui::PopID(); + } + + for (int row = 0; row < 5; row++) + { + ImGui::TableNextRow(); + for (int column = 0; column < 3; column++) + { + char buf[32]; + sprintf(buf, "Cell %d,%d", column, row); + ImGui::TableSetColumnIndex(column); + ImGui::Selectable(buf, column_selected[column]); + } + } + ImGui::EndTable(); + } + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + // Demonstrate creating custom context menus inside columns, while playing it nice with context menus provided by TableHeadersRow()/TableHeader() + if (open_action != -1) + ImGui::SetNextItemOpen(open_action != 0); + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Context menus")) + { + HelpMarker("By default, right-clicking over a TableHeadersRow()/TableHeader() line will open the default context-menu.\nUsing ImGuiTableFlags_ContextMenuInBody we also allow right-clicking over columns body."); + static ImGuiTableFlags flags1 = ImGuiTableFlags_Resizable | ImGuiTableFlags_Reorderable | ImGuiTableFlags_Hideable | ImGuiTableFlags_Borders | ImGuiTableFlags_ContextMenuInBody; + + PushStyleCompact(); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_ContextMenuInBody", &flags1, ImGuiTableFlags_ContextMenuInBody); + PopStyleCompact(); + + // Context Menus: first example + // [1.1] Right-click on the TableHeadersRow() line to open the default table context menu. + // [1.2] Right-click in columns also open the default table context menu (if ImGuiTableFlags_ContextMenuInBody is set) + const int COLUMNS_COUNT = 3; + if (ImGui::BeginTable("table_context_menu", COLUMNS_COUNT, flags1)) + { + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("One"); + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("Two"); + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("Three"); + + // [1.1]] Right-click on the TableHeadersRow() line to open the default table context menu. + ImGui::TableHeadersRow(); + + // Submit dummy contents + for (int row = 0; row < 4; row++) + { + ImGui::TableNextRow(); + for (int column = 0; column < COLUMNS_COUNT; column++) + { + ImGui::TableSetColumnIndex(column); + ImGui::Text("Cell %d,%d", column, row); + } + } + ImGui::EndTable(); + } + + // Context Menus: second example + // [2.1] Right-click on the TableHeadersRow() line to open the default table context menu. + // [2.2] Right-click on the ".." to open a custom popup + // [2.3] Right-click in columns to open another custom popup + HelpMarker("Demonstrate mixing table context menu (over header), item context button (over button) and custom per-colum context menu (over column body)."); + ImGuiTableFlags flags2 = ImGuiTableFlags_Resizable | ImGuiTableFlags_SizingFixedFit | ImGuiTableFlags_Reorderable | ImGuiTableFlags_Hideable | ImGuiTableFlags_Borders; + if (ImGui::BeginTable("table_context_menu_2", COLUMNS_COUNT, flags2)) + { + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("One"); + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("Two"); + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("Three"); + + // [2.1] Right-click on the TableHeadersRow() line to open the default table context menu. + ImGui::TableHeadersRow(); + for (int row = 0; row < 4; row++) + { + ImGui::TableNextRow(); + for (int column = 0; column < COLUMNS_COUNT; column++) + { + // Submit dummy contents + ImGui::TableSetColumnIndex(column); + ImGui::Text("Cell %d,%d", column, row); + ImGui::SameLine(); + + // [2.2] Right-click on the ".." to open a custom popup + ImGui::PushID(row * COLUMNS_COUNT + column); + ImGui::SmallButton(".."); + if (ImGui::BeginPopupContextItem()) + { + ImGui::Text("This is the popup for Button(\"..\") in Cell %d,%d", column, row); + if (ImGui::Button("Close")) + ImGui::CloseCurrentPopup(); + ImGui::EndPopup(); + } + ImGui::PopID(); + } + } + + // [2.3] Right-click anywhere in columns to open another custom popup + // (instead of testing for !IsAnyItemHovered() we could also call OpenPopup() with ImGuiPopupFlags_NoOpenOverExistingPopup + // to manage popup priority as the popups triggers, here "are we hovering a column" are overlapping) + int hovered_column = -1; + for (int column = 0; column < COLUMNS_COUNT + 1; column++) + { + ImGui::PushID(column); + if (ImGui::TableGetColumnFlags(column) & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_IsHovered) + hovered_column = column; + if (hovered_column == column && !ImGui::IsAnyItemHovered() && ImGui::IsMouseReleased(1)) + ImGui::OpenPopup("MyPopup"); + if (ImGui::BeginPopup("MyPopup")) + { + if (column == COLUMNS_COUNT) + ImGui::Text("This is a custom popup for unused space after the last column."); + else + ImGui::Text("This is a custom popup for Column %d", column); + if (ImGui::Button("Close")) + ImGui::CloseCurrentPopup(); + ImGui::EndPopup(); + } + ImGui::PopID(); + } + + ImGui::EndTable(); + ImGui::Text("Hovered column: %d", hovered_column); + } + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + // Demonstrate creating multiple tables with the same ID + if (open_action != -1) + ImGui::SetNextItemOpen(open_action != 0); + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Synced instances")) + { + HelpMarker("Multiple tables with the same identifier will share their settings, width, visibility, order etc."); + for (int n = 0; n < 3; n++) + { + char buf[32]; + sprintf(buf, "Synced Table %d", n); + bool open = ImGui::CollapsingHeader(buf, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_DefaultOpen); + if (open && ImGui::BeginTable("Table", 3, ImGuiTableFlags_Resizable | ImGuiTableFlags_Reorderable | ImGuiTableFlags_Hideable | ImGuiTableFlags_Borders | ImGuiTableFlags_SizingFixedFit | ImGuiTableFlags_NoSavedSettings)) + { + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("One"); + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("Two"); + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("Three"); + ImGui::TableHeadersRow(); + for (int cell = 0; cell < 9; cell++) + { + ImGui::TableNextColumn(); + ImGui::Text("this cell %d", cell); + } + ImGui::EndTable(); + } + } + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + // Demonstrate using Sorting facilities + // This is a simplified version of the "Advanced" example, where we mostly focus on the code necessary to handle sorting. + // Note that the "Advanced" example also showcase manually triggering a sort (e.g. if item quantities have been modified) + static const char* template_items_names[] = + { + "Banana", "Apple", "Cherry", "Watermelon", "Grapefruit", "Strawberry", "Mango", + "Kiwi", "Orange", "Pineapple", "Blueberry", "Plum", "Coconut", "Pear", "Apricot" + }; + if (open_action != -1) + ImGui::SetNextItemOpen(open_action != 0); + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Sorting")) + { + // Create item list + static ImVector items; + if (items.Size == 0) + { + items.resize(50, MyItem()); + for (int n = 0; n < items.Size; n++) + { + const int template_n = n % IM_ARRAYSIZE(template_items_names); + MyItem& item = items[n]; + item.ID = n; + item.Name = template_items_names[template_n]; + item.Quantity = (n * n - n) % 20; // Assign default quantities + } + } + + // Options + static ImGuiTableFlags flags = + ImGuiTableFlags_Resizable | ImGuiTableFlags_Reorderable | ImGuiTableFlags_Hideable | ImGuiTableFlags_Sortable | ImGuiTableFlags_SortMulti + | ImGuiTableFlags_RowBg | ImGuiTableFlags_BordersOuter | ImGuiTableFlags_BordersV | ImGuiTableFlags_NoBordersInBody + | ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollY; + PushStyleCompact(); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_SortMulti", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_SortMulti); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("When sorting is enabled: hold shift when clicking headers to sort on multiple column. TableGetSortSpecs() may return specs where (SpecsCount > 1)."); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_SortTristate", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_SortTristate); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("When sorting is enabled: allow no sorting, disable default sorting. TableGetSortSpecs() may return specs where (SpecsCount == 0)."); + PopStyleCompact(); + + if (ImGui::BeginTable("table_sorting", 4, flags, ImVec2(0.0f, TEXT_BASE_HEIGHT * 15), 0.0f)) + { + // Declare columns + // We use the "user_id" parameter of TableSetupColumn() to specify a user id that will be stored in the sort specifications. + // This is so our sort function can identify a column given our own identifier. We could also identify them based on their index! + // Demonstrate using a mixture of flags among available sort-related flags: + // - ImGuiTableColumnFlags_DefaultSort + // - ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoSort / ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoSortAscending / ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoSortDescending + // - ImGuiTableColumnFlags_PreferSortAscending / ImGuiTableColumnFlags_PreferSortDescending + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("ID", ImGuiTableColumnFlags_DefaultSort | ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthFixed, 0.0f, MyItemColumnID_ID); + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("Name", ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthFixed, 0.0f, MyItemColumnID_Name); + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("Action", ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoSort | ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthFixed, 0.0f, MyItemColumnID_Action); + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("Quantity", ImGuiTableColumnFlags_PreferSortDescending | ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthStretch, 0.0f, MyItemColumnID_Quantity); + ImGui::TableSetupScrollFreeze(0, 1); // Make row always visible + ImGui::TableHeadersRow(); + + // Sort our data if sort specs have been changed! + if (ImGuiTableSortSpecs* sorts_specs = ImGui::TableGetSortSpecs()) + if (sorts_specs->SpecsDirty) + { + MyItem::s_current_sort_specs = sorts_specs; // Store in variable accessible by the sort function. + if (items.Size > 1) + qsort(&items[0], (size_t)items.Size, sizeof(items[0]), MyItem::CompareWithSortSpecs); + MyItem::s_current_sort_specs = NULL; + sorts_specs->SpecsDirty = false; + } + + // Demonstrate using clipper for large vertical lists + ImGuiListClipper clipper; + clipper.Begin(items.Size); + while (clipper.Step()) + for (int row_n = clipper.DisplayStart; row_n < clipper.DisplayEnd; row_n++) + { + // Display a data item + MyItem* item = &items[row_n]; + ImGui::PushID(item->ID); + ImGui::TableNextRow(); + ImGui::TableNextColumn(); + ImGui::Text("%04d", item->ID); + ImGui::TableNextColumn(); + ImGui::TextUnformatted(item->Name); + ImGui::TableNextColumn(); + ImGui::SmallButton("None"); + ImGui::TableNextColumn(); + ImGui::Text("%d", item->Quantity); + ImGui::PopID(); + } + ImGui::EndTable(); + } + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + // In this example we'll expose most table flags and settings. + // For specific flags and settings refer to the corresponding section for more detailed explanation. + // This section is mostly useful to experiment with combining certain flags or settings with each others. + //ImGui::SetNextItemOpen(true, ImGuiCond_Once); // [DEBUG] + if (open_action != -1) + ImGui::SetNextItemOpen(open_action != 0); + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Advanced")) + { + static ImGuiTableFlags flags = + ImGuiTableFlags_Resizable | ImGuiTableFlags_Reorderable | ImGuiTableFlags_Hideable + | ImGuiTableFlags_Sortable | ImGuiTableFlags_SortMulti + | ImGuiTableFlags_RowBg | ImGuiTableFlags_Borders | ImGuiTableFlags_NoBordersInBody + | ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollX | ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollY + | ImGuiTableFlags_SizingFixedFit; + + enum ContentsType { CT_Text, CT_Button, CT_SmallButton, CT_FillButton, CT_Selectable, CT_SelectableSpanRow }; + static int contents_type = CT_SelectableSpanRow; + const char* contents_type_names[] = { "Text", "Button", "SmallButton", "FillButton", "Selectable", "Selectable (span row)" }; + static int freeze_cols = 1; + static int freeze_rows = 1; + static int items_count = IM_ARRAYSIZE(template_items_names) * 2; + static ImVec2 outer_size_value = ImVec2(0.0f, TEXT_BASE_HEIGHT * 12); + static float row_min_height = 0.0f; // Auto + static float inner_width_with_scroll = 0.0f; // Auto-extend + static bool outer_size_enabled = true; + static bool show_headers = true; + static bool show_wrapped_text = false; + //static ImGuiTextFilter filter; + //ImGui::SetNextItemOpen(true, ImGuiCond_Once); // FIXME-TABLE: Enabling this results in initial clipped first pass on table which tend to affects column sizing + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Options")) + { + // Make the UI compact because there are so many fields + PushStyleCompact(); + ImGui::PushItemWidth(TEXT_BASE_WIDTH * 28.0f); + + if (ImGui::TreeNodeEx("Features:", ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_DefaultOpen)) + { + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_Resizable", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_Resizable); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_Reorderable", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_Reorderable); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_Hideable", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_Hideable); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_Sortable", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_Sortable); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_NoSavedSettings", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_NoSavedSettings); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_ContextMenuInBody", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_ContextMenuInBody); + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (ImGui::TreeNodeEx("Decorations:", ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_DefaultOpen)) + { + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_RowBg", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_RowBg); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_BordersV", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_BordersV); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_BordersOuterV", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_BordersOuterV); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_BordersInnerV", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_BordersInnerV); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_BordersH", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_BordersH); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_BordersOuterH", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_BordersOuterH); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_BordersInnerH", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_BordersInnerH); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_NoBordersInBody", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_NoBordersInBody); ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Disable vertical borders in columns Body (borders will always appears in Headers"); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_NoBordersInBodyUntilResize", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_NoBordersInBodyUntilResize); ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Disable vertical borders in columns Body until hovered for resize (borders will always appears in Headers)"); + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (ImGui::TreeNodeEx("Sizing:", ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_DefaultOpen)) + { + EditTableSizingFlags(&flags); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("In the Advanced demo we override the policy of each column so those table-wide settings have less effect that typical."); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_NoHostExtendX", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_NoHostExtendX); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Make outer width auto-fit to columns, overriding outer_size.x value.\n\nOnly available when ScrollX/ScrollY are disabled and Stretch columns are not used."); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_NoHostExtendY", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_NoHostExtendY); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Make outer height stop exactly at outer_size.y (prevent auto-extending table past the limit).\n\nOnly available when ScrollX/ScrollY are disabled. Data below the limit will be clipped and not visible."); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_NoKeepColumnsVisible", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_NoKeepColumnsVisible); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Only available if ScrollX is disabled."); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_PreciseWidths", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_PreciseWidths); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Disable distributing remainder width to stretched columns (width allocation on a 100-wide table with 3 columns: Without this flag: 33,33,34. With this flag: 33,33,33). With larger number of columns, resizing will appear to be less smooth."); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_NoClip", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_NoClip); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Disable clipping rectangle for every individual columns (reduce draw command count, items will be able to overflow into other columns). Generally incompatible with ScrollFreeze options."); + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (ImGui::TreeNodeEx("Padding:", ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_DefaultOpen)) + { + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_PadOuterX", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_PadOuterX); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_NoPadOuterX", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_NoPadOuterX); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_NoPadInnerX", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_NoPadInnerX); + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (ImGui::TreeNodeEx("Scrolling:", ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_DefaultOpen)) + { + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollX", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollX); + ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::SetNextItemWidth(ImGui::GetFrameHeight()); + ImGui::DragInt("freeze_cols", &freeze_cols, 0.2f, 0, 9, NULL, ImGuiSliderFlags_NoInput); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollY", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollY); + ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::SetNextItemWidth(ImGui::GetFrameHeight()); + ImGui::DragInt("freeze_rows", &freeze_rows, 0.2f, 0, 9, NULL, ImGuiSliderFlags_NoInput); + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (ImGui::TreeNodeEx("Sorting:", ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_DefaultOpen)) + { + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_SortMulti", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_SortMulti); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("When sorting is enabled: hold shift when clicking headers to sort on multiple column. TableGetSortSpecs() may return specs where (SpecsCount > 1)."); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_SortTristate", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_SortTristate); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("When sorting is enabled: allow no sorting, disable default sorting. TableGetSortSpecs() may return specs where (SpecsCount == 0)."); + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (ImGui::TreeNodeEx("Other:", ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_DefaultOpen)) + { + ImGui::Checkbox("show_headers", &show_headers); + ImGui::Checkbox("show_wrapped_text", &show_wrapped_text); + + ImGui::DragFloat2("##OuterSize", &outer_size_value.x); + ImGui::SameLine(0.0f, ImGui::GetStyle().ItemInnerSpacing.x); + ImGui::Checkbox("outer_size", &outer_size_enabled); + ImGui::SameLine(); + HelpMarker("If scrolling is disabled (ScrollX and ScrollY not set):\n" + "- The table is output directly in the parent window.\n" + "- OuterSize.x < 0.0f will right-align the table.\n" + "- OuterSize.x = 0.0f will narrow fit the table unless there are any Stretch column.\n" + "- OuterSize.y then becomes the minimum size for the table, which will extend vertically if there are more rows (unless NoHostExtendY is set)."); + + // From a user point of view we will tend to use 'inner_width' differently depending on whether our table is embedding scrolling. + // To facilitate toying with this demo we will actually pass 0.0f to the BeginTable() when ScrollX is disabled. + ImGui::DragFloat("inner_width (when ScrollX active)", &inner_width_with_scroll, 1.0f, 0.0f, FLT_MAX); + + ImGui::DragFloat("row_min_height", &row_min_height, 1.0f, 0.0f, FLT_MAX); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Specify height of the Selectable item."); + + ImGui::DragInt("items_count", &items_count, 0.1f, 0, 9999); + ImGui::Combo("items_type (first column)", &contents_type, contents_type_names, IM_ARRAYSIZE(contents_type_names)); + //filter.Draw("filter"); + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + ImGui::PopItemWidth(); + PopStyleCompact(); + ImGui::Spacing(); + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + // Update item list if we changed the number of items + static ImVector items; + static ImVector selection; + static bool items_need_sort = false; + if (items.Size != items_count) + { + items.resize(items_count, MyItem()); + for (int n = 0; n < items_count; n++) + { + const int template_n = n % IM_ARRAYSIZE(template_items_names); + MyItem& item = items[n]; + item.ID = n; + item.Name = template_items_names[template_n]; + item.Quantity = (template_n == 3) ? 10 : (template_n == 4) ? 20 : 0; // Assign default quantities + } + } + + const ImDrawList* parent_draw_list = ImGui::GetWindowDrawList(); + const int parent_draw_list_draw_cmd_count = parent_draw_list->CmdBuffer.Size; + ImVec2 table_scroll_cur, table_scroll_max; // For debug display + const ImDrawList* table_draw_list = NULL; // " + + // Submit table + const float inner_width_to_use = (flags & ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollX) ? inner_width_with_scroll : 0.0f; + if (ImGui::BeginTable("table_advanced", 6, flags, outer_size_enabled ? outer_size_value : ImVec2(0, 0), inner_width_to_use)) + { + // Declare columns + // We use the "user_id" parameter of TableSetupColumn() to specify a user id that will be stored in the sort specifications. + // This is so our sort function can identify a column given our own identifier. We could also identify them based on their index! + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("ID", ImGuiTableColumnFlags_DefaultSort | ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthFixed | ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoHide, 0.0f, MyItemColumnID_ID); + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("Name", ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthFixed, 0.0f, MyItemColumnID_Name); + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("Action", ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoSort | ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthFixed, 0.0f, MyItemColumnID_Action); + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("Quantity", ImGuiTableColumnFlags_PreferSortDescending, 0.0f, MyItemColumnID_Quantity); + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("Description", (flags & ImGuiTableFlags_NoHostExtendX) ? 0 : ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthStretch, 0.0f, MyItemColumnID_Description); + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("Hidden", ImGuiTableColumnFlags_DefaultHide | ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoSort); + ImGui::TableSetupScrollFreeze(freeze_cols, freeze_rows); + + // Sort our data if sort specs have been changed! + ImGuiTableSortSpecs* sorts_specs = ImGui::TableGetSortSpecs(); + if (sorts_specs && sorts_specs->SpecsDirty) + items_need_sort = true; + if (sorts_specs && items_need_sort && items.Size > 1) + { + MyItem::s_current_sort_specs = sorts_specs; // Store in variable accessible by the sort function. + qsort(&items[0], (size_t)items.Size, sizeof(items[0]), MyItem::CompareWithSortSpecs); + MyItem::s_current_sort_specs = NULL; + sorts_specs->SpecsDirty = false; + } + items_need_sort = false; + + // Take note of whether we are currently sorting based on the Quantity field, + // we will use this to trigger sorting when we know the data of this column has been modified. + const bool sorts_specs_using_quantity = (ImGui::TableGetColumnFlags(3) & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_IsSorted) != 0; + + // Show headers + if (show_headers) + ImGui::TableHeadersRow(); + + // Show data + // FIXME-TABLE FIXME-NAV: How we can get decent up/down even though we have the buttons here? + ImGui::PushButtonRepeat(true); +#if 1 + // Demonstrate using clipper for large vertical lists + ImGuiListClipper clipper; + clipper.Begin(items.Size); + while (clipper.Step()) + { + for (int row_n = clipper.DisplayStart; row_n < clipper.DisplayEnd; row_n++) +#else + // Without clipper + { + for (int row_n = 0; row_n < items.Size; row_n++) +#endif + { + MyItem* item = &items[row_n]; + //if (!filter.PassFilter(item->Name)) + // continue; + + const bool item_is_selected = selection.contains(item->ID); + ImGui::PushID(item->ID); + ImGui::TableNextRow(ImGuiTableRowFlags_None, row_min_height); + + // For the demo purpose we can select among different type of items submitted in the first column + ImGui::TableSetColumnIndex(0); + char label[32]; + sprintf(label, "%04d", item->ID); + if (contents_type == CT_Text) + ImGui::TextUnformatted(label); + else if (contents_type == CT_Button) + ImGui::Button(label); + else if (contents_type == CT_SmallButton) + ImGui::SmallButton(label); + else if (contents_type == CT_FillButton) + ImGui::Button(label, ImVec2(-FLT_MIN, 0.0f)); + else if (contents_type == CT_Selectable || contents_type == CT_SelectableSpanRow) + { + ImGuiSelectableFlags selectable_flags = (contents_type == CT_SelectableSpanRow) ? ImGuiSelectableFlags_SpanAllColumns | ImGuiSelectableFlags_AllowItemOverlap : ImGuiSelectableFlags_None; + if (ImGui::Selectable(label, item_is_selected, selectable_flags, ImVec2(0, row_min_height))) + { + if (ImGui::GetIO().KeyCtrl) + { + if (item_is_selected) + selection.find_erase_unsorted(item->ID); + else + selection.push_back(item->ID); + } + else + { + selection.clear(); + selection.push_back(item->ID); + } + } + } + + if (ImGui::TableSetColumnIndex(1)) + ImGui::TextUnformatted(item->Name); + + // Here we demonstrate marking our data set as needing to be sorted again if we modified a quantity, + // and we are currently sorting on the column showing the Quantity. + // To avoid triggering a sort while holding the button, we only trigger it when the button has been released. + // You will probably need a more advanced system in your code if you want to automatically sort when a specific entry changes. + if (ImGui::TableSetColumnIndex(2)) + { + if (ImGui::SmallButton("Chop")) { item->Quantity += 1; } + if (sorts_specs_using_quantity && ImGui::IsItemDeactivated()) { items_need_sort = true; } + ImGui::SameLine(); + if (ImGui::SmallButton("Eat")) { item->Quantity -= 1; } + if (sorts_specs_using_quantity && ImGui::IsItemDeactivated()) { items_need_sort = true; } + } + + if (ImGui::TableSetColumnIndex(3)) + ImGui::Text("%d", item->Quantity); + + ImGui::TableSetColumnIndex(4); + if (show_wrapped_text) + ImGui::TextWrapped("Lorem ipsum dolor sit amet"); + else + ImGui::Text("Lorem ipsum dolor sit amet"); + + if (ImGui::TableSetColumnIndex(5)) + ImGui::Text("1234"); + + ImGui::PopID(); + } + } + ImGui::PopButtonRepeat(); + + // Store some info to display debug details below + table_scroll_cur = ImVec2(ImGui::GetScrollX(), ImGui::GetScrollY()); + table_scroll_max = ImVec2(ImGui::GetScrollMaxX(), ImGui::GetScrollMaxY()); + table_draw_list = ImGui::GetWindowDrawList(); + ImGui::EndTable(); + } + static bool show_debug_details = false; + ImGui::Checkbox("Debug details", &show_debug_details); + if (show_debug_details && table_draw_list) + { + ImGui::SameLine(0.0f, 0.0f); + const int table_draw_list_draw_cmd_count = table_draw_list->CmdBuffer.Size; + if (table_draw_list == parent_draw_list) + ImGui::Text(": DrawCmd: +%d (in same window)", + table_draw_list_draw_cmd_count - parent_draw_list_draw_cmd_count); + else + ImGui::Text(": DrawCmd: +%d (in child window), Scroll: (%.f/%.f) (%.f/%.f)", + table_draw_list_draw_cmd_count - 1, table_scroll_cur.x, table_scroll_max.x, table_scroll_cur.y, table_scroll_max.y); + } + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + ImGui::PopID(); + + ShowDemoWindowColumns(); + + if (disable_indent) + ImGui::PopStyleVar(); +} + +// Demonstrate old/legacy Columns API! +// [2020: Columns are under-featured and not maintained. Prefer using the more flexible and powerful BeginTable() API!] +static void ShowDemoWindowColumns() +{ + bool open = ImGui::TreeNode("Legacy Columns API"); + ImGui::SameLine(); + HelpMarker("Columns() is an old API! Prefer using the more flexible and powerful BeginTable() API!"); + if (!open) + return; + + // Basic columns + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Basic")) + { + ImGui::Text("Without border:"); + ImGui::Columns(3, "mycolumns3", false); // 3-ways, no border + ImGui::Separator(); + for (int n = 0; n < 14; n++) + { + char label[32]; + sprintf(label, "Item %d", n); + if (ImGui::Selectable(label)) {} + //if (ImGui::Button(label, ImVec2(-FLT_MIN,0.0f))) {} + ImGui::NextColumn(); + } + ImGui::Columns(1); + ImGui::Separator(); + + ImGui::Text("With border:"); + ImGui::Columns(4, "mycolumns"); // 4-ways, with border + ImGui::Separator(); + ImGui::Text("ID"); ImGui::NextColumn(); + ImGui::Text("Name"); ImGui::NextColumn(); + ImGui::Text("Path"); ImGui::NextColumn(); + ImGui::Text("Hovered"); ImGui::NextColumn(); + ImGui::Separator(); + const char* names[3] = { "One", "Two", "Three" }; + const char* paths[3] = { "/path/one", "/path/two", "/path/three" }; + static int selected = -1; + for (int i = 0; i < 3; i++) + { + char label[32]; + sprintf(label, "%04d", i); + if (ImGui::Selectable(label, selected == i, ImGuiSelectableFlags_SpanAllColumns)) + selected = i; + bool hovered = ImGui::IsItemHovered(); + ImGui::NextColumn(); + ImGui::Text(names[i]); ImGui::NextColumn(); + ImGui::Text(paths[i]); ImGui::NextColumn(); + ImGui::Text("%d", hovered); ImGui::NextColumn(); + } + ImGui::Columns(1); + ImGui::Separator(); + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Borders")) + { + // NB: Future columns API should allow automatic horizontal borders. + static bool h_borders = true; + static bool v_borders = true; + static int columns_count = 4; + const int lines_count = 3; + ImGui::SetNextItemWidth(ImGui::GetFontSize() * 8); + ImGui::DragInt("##columns_count", &columns_count, 0.1f, 2, 10, "%d columns"); + if (columns_count < 2) + columns_count = 2; + ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::Checkbox("horizontal", &h_borders); + ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::Checkbox("vertical", &v_borders); + ImGui::Columns(columns_count, NULL, v_borders); + for (int i = 0; i < columns_count * lines_count; i++) + { + if (h_borders && ImGui::GetColumnIndex() == 0) + ImGui::Separator(); + ImGui::Text("%c%c%c", 'a' + i, 'a' + i, 'a' + i); + ImGui::Text("Width %.2f", ImGui::GetColumnWidth()); + ImGui::Text("Avail %.2f", ImGui::GetContentRegionAvail().x); + ImGui::Text("Offset %.2f", ImGui::GetColumnOffset()); + ImGui::Text("Long text that is likely to clip"); + ImGui::Button("Button", ImVec2(-FLT_MIN, 0.0f)); + ImGui::NextColumn(); + } + ImGui::Columns(1); + if (h_borders) + ImGui::Separator(); + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + // Create multiple items in a same cell before switching to next column + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Mixed items")) + { + ImGui::Columns(3, "mixed"); + ImGui::Separator(); + + ImGui::Text("Hello"); + ImGui::Button("Banana"); + ImGui::NextColumn(); + + ImGui::Text("ImGui"); + ImGui::Button("Apple"); + static float foo = 1.0f; + ImGui::InputFloat("red", &foo, 0.05f, 0, "%.3f"); + ImGui::Text("An extra line here."); + ImGui::NextColumn(); + + ImGui::Text("Sailor"); + ImGui::Button("Corniflower"); + static float bar = 1.0f; + ImGui::InputFloat("blue", &bar, 0.05f, 0, "%.3f"); + ImGui::NextColumn(); + + if (ImGui::CollapsingHeader("Category A")) { ImGui::Text("Blah blah blah"); } ImGui::NextColumn(); + if (ImGui::CollapsingHeader("Category B")) { ImGui::Text("Blah blah blah"); } ImGui::NextColumn(); + if (ImGui::CollapsingHeader("Category C")) { ImGui::Text("Blah blah blah"); } ImGui::NextColumn(); + ImGui::Columns(1); + ImGui::Separator(); + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + // Word wrapping + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Word-wrapping")) + { + ImGui::Columns(2, "word-wrapping"); + ImGui::Separator(); + ImGui::TextWrapped("The quick brown fox jumps over the lazy dog."); + ImGui::TextWrapped("Hello Left"); + ImGui::NextColumn(); + ImGui::TextWrapped("The quick brown fox jumps over the lazy dog."); + ImGui::TextWrapped("Hello Right"); + ImGui::Columns(1); + ImGui::Separator(); + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Horizontal Scrolling")) + { + ImGui::SetNextWindowContentSize(ImVec2(1500.0f, 0.0f)); + ImVec2 child_size = ImVec2(0, ImGui::GetFontSize() * 20.0f); + ImGui::BeginChild("##ScrollingRegion", child_size, false, ImGuiWindowFlags_HorizontalScrollbar); + ImGui::Columns(10); + + // Also demonstrate using clipper for large vertical lists + int ITEMS_COUNT = 2000; + ImGuiListClipper clipper; + clipper.Begin(ITEMS_COUNT); + while (clipper.Step()) + { + for (int i = clipper.DisplayStart; i < clipper.DisplayEnd; i++) + for (int j = 0; j < 10; j++) + { + ImGui::Text("Line %d Column %d...", i, j); + ImGui::NextColumn(); + } + } + ImGui::Columns(1); + ImGui::EndChild(); + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Tree")) + { + ImGui::Columns(2, "tree", true); + for (int x = 0; x < 3; x++) + { + bool open1 = ImGui::TreeNode((void*)(intptr_t)x, "Node%d", x); + ImGui::NextColumn(); + ImGui::Text("Node contents"); + ImGui::NextColumn(); + if (open1) + { + for (int y = 0; y < 3; y++) + { + bool open2 = ImGui::TreeNode((void*)(intptr_t)y, "Node%d.%d", x, y); + ImGui::NextColumn(); + ImGui::Text("Node contents"); + if (open2) + { + ImGui::Text("Even more contents"); + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Tree in column")) + { + ImGui::Text("The quick brown fox jumps over the lazy dog"); + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + } + ImGui::NextColumn(); + if (open2) + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + } + ImGui::Columns(1); + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + ImGui::TreePop(); +} + +static void ShowDemoWindowMisc() +{ + if (ImGui::CollapsingHeader("Filtering")) + { + // Helper class to easy setup a text filter. + // You may want to implement a more feature-full filtering scheme in your own application. + static ImGuiTextFilter filter; + ImGui::Text("Filter usage:\n" + " \"\" display all lines\n" + " \"xxx\" display lines containing \"xxx\"\n" + " \"xxx,yyy\" display lines containing \"xxx\" or \"yyy\"\n" + " \"-xxx\" hide lines containing \"xxx\""); + filter.Draw(); + const char* lines[] = { "aaa1.c", "bbb1.c", "ccc1.c", "aaa2.cpp", "bbb2.cpp", "ccc2.cpp", "abc.h", "hello, world" }; + for (int i = 0; i < IM_ARRAYSIZE(lines); i++) + if (filter.PassFilter(lines[i])) + ImGui::BulletText("%s", lines[i]); + } + + if (ImGui::CollapsingHeader("Inputs, Navigation & Focus")) + { + ImGuiIO& io = ImGui::GetIO(); + + // Display ImGuiIO output flags + ImGui::Text("WantCaptureMouse: %d", io.WantCaptureMouse); + ImGui::Text("WantCaptureKeyboard: %d", io.WantCaptureKeyboard); + ImGui::Text("WantTextInput: %d", io.WantTextInput); + ImGui::Text("WantSetMousePos: %d", io.WantSetMousePos); + ImGui::Text("NavActive: %d, NavVisible: %d", io.NavActive, io.NavVisible); + + // Display Mouse state + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Mouse State")) + { + if (ImGui::IsMousePosValid()) + ImGui::Text("Mouse pos: (%g, %g)", io.MousePos.x, io.MousePos.y); + else + ImGui::Text("Mouse pos: "); + ImGui::Text("Mouse delta: (%g, %g)", io.MouseDelta.x, io.MouseDelta.y); + ImGui::Text("Mouse down:"); for (int i = 0; i < IM_ARRAYSIZE(io.MouseDown); i++) if (ImGui::IsMouseDown(i)) { ImGui::SameLine(); ImGui::Text("b%d (%.02f secs)", i, io.MouseDownDuration[i]); } + ImGui::Text("Mouse clicked:"); for (int i = 0; i < IM_ARRAYSIZE(io.MouseDown); i++) if (ImGui::IsMouseClicked(i)) { ImGui::SameLine(); ImGui::Text("b%d", i); } + ImGui::Text("Mouse dblclick:"); for (int i = 0; i < IM_ARRAYSIZE(io.MouseDown); i++) if (ImGui::IsMouseDoubleClicked(i)){ ImGui::SameLine(); ImGui::Text("b%d", i); } + ImGui::Text("Mouse released:"); for (int i = 0; i < IM_ARRAYSIZE(io.MouseDown); i++) if (ImGui::IsMouseReleased(i)) { ImGui::SameLine(); ImGui::Text("b%d", i); } + ImGui::Text("Mouse wheel: %.1f", io.MouseWheel); + ImGui::Text("Pen Pressure: %.1f", io.PenPressure); // Note: currently unused + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + // Display Keyboard/Mouse state + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Keyboard & Navigation State")) + { + ImGui::Text("Keys down:"); for (int i = 0; i < IM_ARRAYSIZE(io.KeysDown); i++) if (ImGui::IsKeyDown(i)) { ImGui::SameLine(); ImGui::Text("%d (0x%X) (%.02f secs)", i, i, io.KeysDownDuration[i]); } + ImGui::Text("Keys pressed:"); for (int i = 0; i < IM_ARRAYSIZE(io.KeysDown); i++) if (ImGui::IsKeyPressed(i)) { ImGui::SameLine(); ImGui::Text("%d (0x%X)", i, i); } + ImGui::Text("Keys release:"); for (int i = 0; i < IM_ARRAYSIZE(io.KeysDown); i++) if (ImGui::IsKeyReleased(i)) { ImGui::SameLine(); ImGui::Text("%d (0x%X)", i, i); } + ImGui::Text("Keys mods: %s%s%s%s", io.KeyCtrl ? "CTRL " : "", io.KeyShift ? "SHIFT " : "", io.KeyAlt ? "ALT " : "", io.KeySuper ? "SUPER " : ""); + ImGui::Text("Chars queue:"); for (int i = 0; i < io.InputQueueCharacters.Size; i++) { ImWchar c = io.InputQueueCharacters[i]; ImGui::SameLine(); ImGui::Text("\'%c\' (0x%04X)", (c > ' ' && c <= 255) ? (char)c : '?', c); } // FIXME: We should convert 'c' to UTF-8 here but the functions are not public. + + ImGui::Text("NavInputs down:"); for (int i = 0; i < IM_ARRAYSIZE(io.NavInputs); i++) if (io.NavInputs[i] > 0.0f) { ImGui::SameLine(); ImGui::Text("[%d] %.2f (%.02f secs)", i, io.NavInputs[i], io.NavInputsDownDuration[i]); } + ImGui::Text("NavInputs pressed:"); for (int i = 0; i < IM_ARRAYSIZE(io.NavInputs); i++) if (io.NavInputsDownDuration[i] == 0.0f) { ImGui::SameLine(); ImGui::Text("[%d]", i); } + + ImGui::Button("Hovering me sets the\nkeyboard capture flag"); + if (ImGui::IsItemHovered()) + ImGui::CaptureKeyboardFromApp(true); + ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::Button("Holding me clears the\nthe keyboard capture flag"); + if (ImGui::IsItemActive()) + ImGui::CaptureKeyboardFromApp(false); + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Tabbing")) + { + ImGui::Text("Use TAB/SHIFT+TAB to cycle through keyboard editable fields."); + static char buf[32] = "hello"; + ImGui::InputText("1", buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf)); + ImGui::InputText("2", buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf)); + ImGui::InputText("3", buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf)); + ImGui::PushAllowKeyboardFocus(false); + ImGui::InputText("4 (tab skip)", buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf)); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Item won't be cycled through when using TAB or Shift+Tab."); + ImGui::PopAllowKeyboardFocus(); + ImGui::InputText("5", buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf)); + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Focus from code")) + { + bool focus_1 = ImGui::Button("Focus on 1"); ImGui::SameLine(); + bool focus_2 = ImGui::Button("Focus on 2"); ImGui::SameLine(); + bool focus_3 = ImGui::Button("Focus on 3"); + int has_focus = 0; + static char buf[128] = "click on a button to set focus"; + + if (focus_1) ImGui::SetKeyboardFocusHere(); + ImGui::InputText("1", buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf)); + if (ImGui::IsItemActive()) has_focus = 1; + + if (focus_2) ImGui::SetKeyboardFocusHere(); + ImGui::InputText("2", buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf)); + if (ImGui::IsItemActive()) has_focus = 2; + + ImGui::PushAllowKeyboardFocus(false); + if (focus_3) ImGui::SetKeyboardFocusHere(); + ImGui::InputText("3 (tab skip)", buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf)); + if (ImGui::IsItemActive()) has_focus = 3; + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Item won't be cycled through when using TAB or Shift+Tab."); + ImGui::PopAllowKeyboardFocus(); + + if (has_focus) + ImGui::Text("Item with focus: %d", has_focus); + else + ImGui::Text("Item with focus: "); + + // Use >= 0 parameter to SetKeyboardFocusHere() to focus an upcoming item + static float f3[3] = { 0.0f, 0.0f, 0.0f }; + int focus_ahead = -1; + if (ImGui::Button("Focus on X")) { focus_ahead = 0; } ImGui::SameLine(); + if (ImGui::Button("Focus on Y")) { focus_ahead = 1; } ImGui::SameLine(); + if (ImGui::Button("Focus on Z")) { focus_ahead = 2; } + if (focus_ahead != -1) ImGui::SetKeyboardFocusHere(focus_ahead); + ImGui::SliderFloat3("Float3", &f3[0], 0.0f, 1.0f); + + ImGui::TextWrapped("NB: Cursor & selection are preserved when refocusing last used item in code."); + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Dragging")) + { + ImGui::TextWrapped("You can use ImGui::GetMouseDragDelta(0) to query for the dragged amount on any widget."); + for (int button = 0; button < 3; button++) + { + ImGui::Text("IsMouseDragging(%d):", button); + ImGui::Text(" w/ default threshold: %d,", ImGui::IsMouseDragging(button)); + ImGui::Text(" w/ zero threshold: %d,", ImGui::IsMouseDragging(button, 0.0f)); + ImGui::Text(" w/ large threshold: %d,", ImGui::IsMouseDragging(button, 20.0f)); + } + + ImGui::Button("Drag Me"); + if (ImGui::IsItemActive()) + ImGui::GetForegroundDrawList()->AddLine(io.MouseClickedPos[0], io.MousePos, ImGui::GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Button), 4.0f); // Draw a line between the button and the mouse cursor + + // Drag operations gets "unlocked" when the mouse has moved past a certain threshold + // (the default threshold is stored in io.MouseDragThreshold). You can request a lower or higher + // threshold using the second parameter of IsMouseDragging() and GetMouseDragDelta(). + ImVec2 value_raw = ImGui::GetMouseDragDelta(0, 0.0f); + ImVec2 value_with_lock_threshold = ImGui::GetMouseDragDelta(0); + ImVec2 mouse_delta = io.MouseDelta; + ImGui::Text("GetMouseDragDelta(0):"); + ImGui::Text(" w/ default threshold: (%.1f, %.1f)", value_with_lock_threshold.x, value_with_lock_threshold.y); + ImGui::Text(" w/ zero threshold: (%.1f, %.1f)", value_raw.x, value_raw.y); + ImGui::Text("io.MouseDelta: (%.1f, %.1f)", mouse_delta.x, mouse_delta.y); + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Mouse cursors")) + { + const char* mouse_cursors_names[] = { "Arrow", "TextInput", "ResizeAll", "ResizeNS", "ResizeEW", "ResizeNESW", "ResizeNWSE", "Hand", "NotAllowed" }; + IM_ASSERT(IM_ARRAYSIZE(mouse_cursors_names) == ImGuiMouseCursor_COUNT); + + ImGuiMouseCursor current = ImGui::GetMouseCursor(); + ImGui::Text("Current mouse cursor = %d: %s", current, mouse_cursors_names[current]); + ImGui::Text("Hover to see mouse cursors:"); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker( + "Your application can render a different mouse cursor based on what ImGui::GetMouseCursor() returns. " + "If software cursor rendering (io.MouseDrawCursor) is set ImGui will draw the right cursor for you, " + "otherwise your backend needs to handle it."); + for (int i = 0; i < ImGuiMouseCursor_COUNT; i++) + { + char label[32]; + sprintf(label, "Mouse cursor %d: %s", i, mouse_cursors_names[i]); + ImGui::Bullet(); ImGui::Selectable(label, false); + if (ImGui::IsItemHovered()) + ImGui::SetMouseCursor(i); + } + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + } +} + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] About Window / ShowAboutWindow() +// Access from Dear ImGui Demo -> Tools -> About +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +void ImGui::ShowAboutWindow(bool* p_open) +{ + if (!ImGui::Begin("About Dear ImGui", p_open, ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize)) + { + ImGui::End(); + return; + } + ImGui::Text("Dear ImGui %s", ImGui::GetVersion()); + ImGui::Separator(); + ImGui::Text("By Omar Cornut and all Dear ImGui contributors."); + ImGui::Text("Dear ImGui is licensed under the MIT License, see LICENSE for more information."); + + static bool show_config_info = false; + ImGui::Checkbox("Config/Build Information", &show_config_info); + if (show_config_info) + { + ImGuiIO& io = ImGui::GetIO(); + ImGuiStyle& style = ImGui::GetStyle(); + + bool copy_to_clipboard = ImGui::Button("Copy to clipboard"); + ImVec2 child_size = ImVec2(0, ImGui::GetTextLineHeightWithSpacing() * 18); + ImGui::BeginChildFrame(ImGui::GetID("cfg_infos"), child_size, ImGuiWindowFlags_NoMove); + if (copy_to_clipboard) + { + ImGui::LogToClipboard(); + ImGui::LogText("```\n"); // Back quotes will make text appears without formatting when pasting on GitHub + } + + ImGui::Text("Dear ImGui %s (%d)", IMGUI_VERSION, IMGUI_VERSION_NUM); + ImGui::Separator(); + ImGui::Text("sizeof(size_t): %d, sizeof(ImDrawIdx): %d, sizeof(ImDrawVert): %d", (int)sizeof(size_t), (int)sizeof(ImDrawIdx), (int)sizeof(ImDrawVert)); + ImGui::Text("define: __cplusplus=%d", (int)__cplusplus); +#ifdef IMGUI_DISABLE_OBSOLETE_FUNCTIONS + ImGui::Text("define: IMGUI_DISABLE_OBSOLETE_FUNCTIONS"); +#endif +#ifdef IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_DEFAULT_CLIPBOARD_FUNCTIONS + ImGui::Text("define: IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_DEFAULT_CLIPBOARD_FUNCTIONS"); +#endif +#ifdef IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_DEFAULT_IME_FUNCTIONS + ImGui::Text("define: IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_DEFAULT_IME_FUNCTIONS"); +#endif +#ifdef IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_FUNCTIONS + ImGui::Text("define: IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_FUNCTIONS"); +#endif +#ifdef IMGUI_DISABLE_DEFAULT_FORMAT_FUNCTIONS + ImGui::Text("define: IMGUI_DISABLE_DEFAULT_FORMAT_FUNCTIONS"); +#endif +#ifdef IMGUI_DISABLE_DEFAULT_MATH_FUNCTIONS + ImGui::Text("define: IMGUI_DISABLE_DEFAULT_MATH_FUNCTIONS"); +#endif +#ifdef IMGUI_DISABLE_DEFAULT_FILE_FUNCTIONS + ImGui::Text("define: IMGUI_DISABLE_DEFAULT_FILE_FUNCTIONS"); +#endif +#ifdef IMGUI_DISABLE_FILE_FUNCTIONS + ImGui::Text("define: IMGUI_DISABLE_FILE_FUNCTIONS"); +#endif +#ifdef IMGUI_DISABLE_DEFAULT_ALLOCATORS + ImGui::Text("define: IMGUI_DISABLE_DEFAULT_ALLOCATORS"); +#endif +#ifdef IMGUI_USE_BGRA_PACKED_COLOR + ImGui::Text("define: IMGUI_USE_BGRA_PACKED_COLOR"); +#endif +#ifdef _WIN32 + ImGui::Text("define: _WIN32"); +#endif +#ifdef _WIN64 + ImGui::Text("define: _WIN64"); +#endif +#ifdef __linux__ + ImGui::Text("define: __linux__"); +#endif +#ifdef __APPLE__ + ImGui::Text("define: __APPLE__"); +#endif +#ifdef _MSC_VER + ImGui::Text("define: _MSC_VER=%d", _MSC_VER); +#endif +#ifdef _MSVC_LANG + ImGui::Text("define: _MSVC_LANG=%d", (int)_MSVC_LANG); +#endif +#ifdef __MINGW32__ + ImGui::Text("define: __MINGW32__"); +#endif +#ifdef __MINGW64__ + ImGui::Text("define: __MINGW64__"); +#endif +#ifdef __GNUC__ + ImGui::Text("define: __GNUC__=%d", (int)__GNUC__); +#endif +#ifdef __clang_version__ + ImGui::Text("define: __clang_version__=%s", __clang_version__); +#endif + ImGui::Separator(); + ImGui::Text("io.BackendPlatformName: %s", io.BackendPlatformName ? io.BackendPlatformName : "NULL"); + ImGui::Text("io.BackendRendererName: %s", io.BackendRendererName ? io.BackendRendererName : "NULL"); + ImGui::Text("io.ConfigFlags: 0x%08X", io.ConfigFlags); + if (io.ConfigFlags & ImGuiConfigFlags_NavEnableKeyboard) ImGui::Text(" NavEnableKeyboard"); + if (io.ConfigFlags & ImGuiConfigFlags_NavEnableGamepad) ImGui::Text(" NavEnableGamepad"); + if (io.ConfigFlags & ImGuiConfigFlags_NavEnableSetMousePos) ImGui::Text(" NavEnableSetMousePos"); + if (io.ConfigFlags & ImGuiConfigFlags_NavNoCaptureKeyboard) ImGui::Text(" NavNoCaptureKeyboard"); + if (io.ConfigFlags & ImGuiConfigFlags_NoMouse) ImGui::Text(" NoMouse"); + if (io.ConfigFlags & ImGuiConfigFlags_NoMouseCursorChange) ImGui::Text(" NoMouseCursorChange"); + if (io.MouseDrawCursor) ImGui::Text("io.MouseDrawCursor"); + if (io.ConfigMacOSXBehaviors) ImGui::Text("io.ConfigMacOSXBehaviors"); + if (io.ConfigInputTextCursorBlink) ImGui::Text("io.ConfigInputTextCursorBlink"); + if (io.ConfigWindowsResizeFromEdges) ImGui::Text("io.ConfigWindowsResizeFromEdges"); + if (io.ConfigWindowsMoveFromTitleBarOnly) ImGui::Text("io.ConfigWindowsMoveFromTitleBarOnly"); + if (io.ConfigMemoryCompactTimer >= 0.0f) ImGui::Text("io.ConfigMemoryCompactTimer = %.1f", io.ConfigMemoryCompactTimer); + ImGui::Text("io.BackendFlags: 0x%08X", io.BackendFlags); + if (io.BackendFlags & ImGuiBackendFlags_HasGamepad) ImGui::Text(" HasGamepad"); + if (io.BackendFlags & ImGuiBackendFlags_HasMouseCursors) ImGui::Text(" HasMouseCursors"); + if (io.BackendFlags & ImGuiBackendFlags_HasSetMousePos) ImGui::Text(" HasSetMousePos"); + if (io.BackendFlags & ImGuiBackendFlags_RendererHasVtxOffset) ImGui::Text(" RendererHasVtxOffset"); + ImGui::Separator(); + ImGui::Text("io.Fonts: %d fonts, Flags: 0x%08X, TexSize: %d,%d", io.Fonts->Fonts.Size, io.Fonts->Flags, io.Fonts->TexWidth, io.Fonts->TexHeight); + ImGui::Text("io.DisplaySize: %.2f,%.2f", io.DisplaySize.x, io.DisplaySize.y); + ImGui::Text("io.DisplayFramebufferScale: %.2f,%.2f", io.DisplayFramebufferScale.x, io.DisplayFramebufferScale.y); + ImGui::Separator(); + ImGui::Text("style.WindowPadding: %.2f,%.2f", style.WindowPadding.x, style.WindowPadding.y); + ImGui::Text("style.WindowBorderSize: %.2f", style.WindowBorderSize); + ImGui::Text("style.FramePadding: %.2f,%.2f", style.FramePadding.x, style.FramePadding.y); + ImGui::Text("style.FrameRounding: %.2f", style.FrameRounding); + ImGui::Text("style.FrameBorderSize: %.2f", style.FrameBorderSize); + ImGui::Text("style.ItemSpacing: %.2f,%.2f", style.ItemSpacing.x, style.ItemSpacing.y); + ImGui::Text("style.ItemInnerSpacing: %.2f,%.2f", style.ItemInnerSpacing.x, style.ItemInnerSpacing.y); + + if (copy_to_clipboard) + { + ImGui::LogText("\n```\n"); + ImGui::LogFinish(); + } + ImGui::EndChildFrame(); + } + ImGui::End(); +} + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Style Editor / ShowStyleEditor() +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// - ShowFontSelector() +// - ShowStyleSelector() +// - ShowStyleEditor() +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// Forward declare ShowFontAtlas() which isn't worth putting in public API yet +namespace ImGui { IMGUI_API void ShowFontAtlas(ImFontAtlas* atlas); } + +// Demo helper function to select among loaded fonts. +// Here we use the regular BeginCombo()/EndCombo() api which is more the more flexible one. +void ImGui::ShowFontSelector(const char* label) +{ + ImGuiIO& io = ImGui::GetIO(); + ImFont* font_current = ImGui::GetFont(); + if (ImGui::BeginCombo(label, font_current->GetDebugName())) + { + for (int n = 0; n < io.Fonts->Fonts.Size; n++) + { + ImFont* font = io.Fonts->Fonts[n]; + ImGui::PushID((void*)font); + if (ImGui::Selectable(font->GetDebugName(), font == font_current)) + io.FontDefault = font; + ImGui::PopID(); + } + ImGui::EndCombo(); + } + ImGui::SameLine(); + HelpMarker( + "- Load additional fonts with io.Fonts->AddFontFromFileTTF().\n" + "- The font atlas is built when calling io.Fonts->GetTexDataAsXXXX() or io.Fonts->Build().\n" + "- Read FAQ and docs/FONTS.md for more details.\n" + "- If you need to add/remove fonts at runtime (e.g. for DPI change), do it before calling NewFrame()."); +} + +// Demo helper function to select among default colors. See ShowStyleEditor() for more advanced options. +// Here we use the simplified Combo() api that packs items into a single literal string. +// Useful for quick combo boxes where the choices are known locally. +bool ImGui::ShowStyleSelector(const char* label) +{ + static int style_idx = -1; + if (ImGui::Combo(label, &style_idx, "Dark\0Light\0Classic\0")) + { + switch (style_idx) + { + case 0: ImGui::StyleColorsDark(); break; + case 1: ImGui::StyleColorsLight(); break; + case 2: ImGui::StyleColorsClassic(); break; + } + return true; + } + return false; +} + +void ImGui::ShowStyleEditor(ImGuiStyle* ref) +{ + // You can pass in a reference ImGuiStyle structure to compare to, revert to and save to + // (without a reference style pointer, we will use one compared locally as a reference) + ImGuiStyle& style = ImGui::GetStyle(); + static ImGuiStyle ref_saved_style; + + // Default to using internal storage as reference + static bool init = true; + if (init && ref == NULL) + ref_saved_style = style; + init = false; + if (ref == NULL) + ref = &ref_saved_style; + + ImGui::PushItemWidth(ImGui::GetWindowWidth() * 0.50f); + + if (ImGui::ShowStyleSelector("Colors##Selector")) + ref_saved_style = style; + ImGui::ShowFontSelector("Fonts##Selector"); + + // Simplified Settings (expose floating-pointer border sizes as boolean representing 0.0f or 1.0f) + if (ImGui::SliderFloat("FrameRounding", &style.FrameRounding, 0.0f, 12.0f, "%.0f")) + style.GrabRounding = style.FrameRounding; // Make GrabRounding always the same value as FrameRounding + { bool border = (style.WindowBorderSize > 0.0f); if (ImGui::Checkbox("WindowBorder", &border)) { style.WindowBorderSize = border ? 1.0f : 0.0f; } } + ImGui::SameLine(); + { bool border = (style.FrameBorderSize > 0.0f); if (ImGui::Checkbox("FrameBorder", &border)) { style.FrameBorderSize = border ? 1.0f : 0.0f; } } + ImGui::SameLine(); + { bool border = (style.PopupBorderSize > 0.0f); if (ImGui::Checkbox("PopupBorder", &border)) { style.PopupBorderSize = border ? 1.0f : 0.0f; } } + + // Save/Revert button + if (ImGui::Button("Save Ref")) + *ref = ref_saved_style = style; + ImGui::SameLine(); + if (ImGui::Button("Revert Ref")) + style = *ref; + ImGui::SameLine(); + HelpMarker( + "Save/Revert in local non-persistent storage. Default Colors definition are not affected. " + "Use \"Export\" below to save them somewhere."); + + ImGui::Separator(); + + if (ImGui::BeginTabBar("##tabs", ImGuiTabBarFlags_None)) + { + if (ImGui::BeginTabItem("Sizes")) + { + ImGui::Text("Main"); + ImGui::SliderFloat2("WindowPadding", (float*)&style.WindowPadding, 0.0f, 20.0f, "%.0f"); + ImGui::SliderFloat2("FramePadding", (float*)&style.FramePadding, 0.0f, 20.0f, "%.0f"); + ImGui::SliderFloat2("CellPadding", (float*)&style.CellPadding, 0.0f, 20.0f, "%.0f"); + ImGui::SliderFloat2("ItemSpacing", (float*)&style.ItemSpacing, 0.0f, 20.0f, "%.0f"); + ImGui::SliderFloat2("ItemInnerSpacing", (float*)&style.ItemInnerSpacing, 0.0f, 20.0f, "%.0f"); + ImGui::SliderFloat2("TouchExtraPadding", (float*)&style.TouchExtraPadding, 0.0f, 10.0f, "%.0f"); + ImGui::SliderFloat("IndentSpacing", &style.IndentSpacing, 0.0f, 30.0f, "%.0f"); + ImGui::SliderFloat("ScrollbarSize", &style.ScrollbarSize, 1.0f, 20.0f, "%.0f"); + ImGui::SliderFloat("GrabMinSize", &style.GrabMinSize, 1.0f, 20.0f, "%.0f"); + ImGui::Text("Borders"); + ImGui::SliderFloat("WindowBorderSize", &style.WindowBorderSize, 0.0f, 1.0f, "%.0f"); + ImGui::SliderFloat("ChildBorderSize", &style.ChildBorderSize, 0.0f, 1.0f, "%.0f"); + ImGui::SliderFloat("PopupBorderSize", &style.PopupBorderSize, 0.0f, 1.0f, "%.0f"); + ImGui::SliderFloat("FrameBorderSize", &style.FrameBorderSize, 0.0f, 1.0f, "%.0f"); + ImGui::SliderFloat("TabBorderSize", &style.TabBorderSize, 0.0f, 1.0f, "%.0f"); + ImGui::Text("Rounding"); + ImGui::SliderFloat("WindowRounding", &style.WindowRounding, 0.0f, 12.0f, "%.0f"); + ImGui::SliderFloat("ChildRounding", &style.ChildRounding, 0.0f, 12.0f, "%.0f"); + ImGui::SliderFloat("FrameRounding", &style.FrameRounding, 0.0f, 12.0f, "%.0f"); + ImGui::SliderFloat("PopupRounding", &style.PopupRounding, 0.0f, 12.0f, "%.0f"); + ImGui::SliderFloat("ScrollbarRounding", &style.ScrollbarRounding, 0.0f, 12.0f, "%.0f"); + ImGui::SliderFloat("GrabRounding", &style.GrabRounding, 0.0f, 12.0f, "%.0f"); + ImGui::SliderFloat("LogSliderDeadzone", &style.LogSliderDeadzone, 0.0f, 12.0f, "%.0f"); + ImGui::SliderFloat("TabRounding", &style.TabRounding, 0.0f, 12.0f, "%.0f"); + ImGui::Text("Alignment"); + ImGui::SliderFloat2("WindowTitleAlign", (float*)&style.WindowTitleAlign, 0.0f, 1.0f, "%.2f"); + int window_menu_button_position = style.WindowMenuButtonPosition + 1; + if (ImGui::Combo("WindowMenuButtonPosition", (int*)&window_menu_button_position, "None\0Left\0Right\0")) + style.WindowMenuButtonPosition = window_menu_button_position - 1; + ImGui::Combo("ColorButtonPosition", (int*)&style.ColorButtonPosition, "Left\0Right\0"); + ImGui::SliderFloat2("ButtonTextAlign", (float*)&style.ButtonTextAlign, 0.0f, 1.0f, "%.2f"); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Alignment applies when a button is larger than its text content."); + ImGui::SliderFloat2("SelectableTextAlign", (float*)&style.SelectableTextAlign, 0.0f, 1.0f, "%.2f"); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Alignment applies when a selectable is larger than its text content."); + ImGui::Text("Safe Area Padding"); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Adjust if you cannot see the edges of your screen (e.g. on a TV where scaling has not been configured)."); + ImGui::SliderFloat2("DisplaySafeAreaPadding", (float*)&style.DisplaySafeAreaPadding, 0.0f, 30.0f, "%.0f"); + ImGui::EndTabItem(); + } + + if (ImGui::BeginTabItem("Colors")) + { + static int output_dest = 0; + static bool output_only_modified = true; + if (ImGui::Button("Export")) + { + if (output_dest == 0) + ImGui::LogToClipboard(); + else + ImGui::LogToTTY(); + ImGui::LogText("ImVec4* colors = ImGui::GetStyle().Colors;" IM_NEWLINE); + for (int i = 0; i < ImGuiCol_COUNT; i++) + { + const ImVec4& col = style.Colors[i]; + const char* name = ImGui::GetStyleColorName(i); + if (!output_only_modified || memcmp(&col, &ref->Colors[i], sizeof(ImVec4)) != 0) + ImGui::LogText("colors[ImGuiCol_%s]%*s= ImVec4(%.2ff, %.2ff, %.2ff, %.2ff);" IM_NEWLINE, + name, 23 - (int)strlen(name), "", col.x, col.y, col.z, col.w); + } + ImGui::LogFinish(); + } + ImGui::SameLine(); ImGui::SetNextItemWidth(120); ImGui::Combo("##output_type", &output_dest, "To Clipboard\0To TTY\0"); + ImGui::SameLine(); ImGui::Checkbox("Only Modified Colors", &output_only_modified); + + static ImGuiTextFilter filter; + filter.Draw("Filter colors", ImGui::GetFontSize() * 16); + + static ImGuiColorEditFlags alpha_flags = 0; + if (ImGui::RadioButton("Opaque", alpha_flags == ImGuiColorEditFlags_None)) { alpha_flags = ImGuiColorEditFlags_None; } ImGui::SameLine(); + if (ImGui::RadioButton("Alpha", alpha_flags == ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaPreview)) { alpha_flags = ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaPreview; } ImGui::SameLine(); + if (ImGui::RadioButton("Both", alpha_flags == ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaPreviewHalf)) { alpha_flags = ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaPreviewHalf; } ImGui::SameLine(); + HelpMarker( + "In the color list:\n" + "Left-click on color square to open color picker,\n" + "Right-click to open edit options menu."); + + ImGui::BeginChild("##colors", ImVec2(0, 0), true, ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysVerticalScrollbar | ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysHorizontalScrollbar | ImGuiWindowFlags_NavFlattened); + ImGui::PushItemWidth(-160); + for (int i = 0; i < ImGuiCol_COUNT; i++) + { + const char* name = ImGui::GetStyleColorName(i); + if (!filter.PassFilter(name)) + continue; + ImGui::PushID(i); + ImGui::ColorEdit4("##color", (float*)&style.Colors[i], ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaBar | alpha_flags); + if (memcmp(&style.Colors[i], &ref->Colors[i], sizeof(ImVec4)) != 0) + { + // Tips: in a real user application, you may want to merge and use an icon font into the main font, + // so instead of "Save"/"Revert" you'd use icons! + // Read the FAQ and docs/FONTS.md about using icon fonts. It's really easy and super convenient! + ImGui::SameLine(0.0f, style.ItemInnerSpacing.x); if (ImGui::Button("Save")) { ref->Colors[i] = style.Colors[i]; } + ImGui::SameLine(0.0f, style.ItemInnerSpacing.x); if (ImGui::Button("Revert")) { style.Colors[i] = ref->Colors[i]; } + } + ImGui::SameLine(0.0f, style.ItemInnerSpacing.x); + ImGui::TextUnformatted(name); + ImGui::PopID(); + } + ImGui::PopItemWidth(); + ImGui::EndChild(); + + ImGui::EndTabItem(); + } + + if (ImGui::BeginTabItem("Fonts")) + { + ImGuiIO& io = ImGui::GetIO(); + ImFontAtlas* atlas = io.Fonts; + HelpMarker("Read FAQ and docs/FONTS.md for details on font loading."); + ImGui::ShowFontAtlas(atlas); + + // Post-baking font scaling. Note that this is NOT the nice way of scaling fonts, read below. + // (we enforce hard clamping manually as by default DragFloat/SliderFloat allows CTRL+Click text to get out of bounds). + const float MIN_SCALE = 0.3f; + const float MAX_SCALE = 2.0f; + HelpMarker( + "Those are old settings provided for convenience.\n" + "However, the _correct_ way of scaling your UI is currently to reload your font at the designed size, " + "rebuild the font atlas, and call style.ScaleAllSizes() on a reference ImGuiStyle structure.\n" + "Using those settings here will give you poor quality results."); + static float window_scale = 1.0f; + ImGui::PushItemWidth(ImGui::GetFontSize() * 8); + if (ImGui::DragFloat("window scale", &window_scale, 0.005f, MIN_SCALE, MAX_SCALE, "%.2f", ImGuiSliderFlags_AlwaysClamp)) // Scale only this window + ImGui::SetWindowFontScale(window_scale); + ImGui::DragFloat("global scale", &io.FontGlobalScale, 0.005f, MIN_SCALE, MAX_SCALE, "%.2f", ImGuiSliderFlags_AlwaysClamp); // Scale everything + ImGui::PopItemWidth(); + + ImGui::EndTabItem(); + } + + if (ImGui::BeginTabItem("Rendering")) + { + ImGui::Checkbox("Anti-aliased lines", &style.AntiAliasedLines); + ImGui::SameLine(); + HelpMarker("When disabling anti-aliasing lines, you'll probably want to disable borders in your style as well."); + + ImGui::Checkbox("Anti-aliased lines use texture", &style.AntiAliasedLinesUseTex); + ImGui::SameLine(); + HelpMarker("Faster lines using texture data. Require backend to render with bilinear filtering (not point/nearest filtering)."); + + ImGui::Checkbox("Anti-aliased fill", &style.AntiAliasedFill); + ImGui::PushItemWidth(ImGui::GetFontSize() * 8); + ImGui::DragFloat("Curve Tessellation Tolerance", &style.CurveTessellationTol, 0.02f, 0.10f, 10.0f, "%.2f"); + if (style.CurveTessellationTol < 0.10f) style.CurveTessellationTol = 0.10f; + + // When editing the "Circle Segment Max Error" value, draw a preview of its effect on auto-tessellated circles. + ImGui::DragFloat("Circle Tessellation Max Error", &style.CircleTessellationMaxError , 0.005f, 0.10f, 5.0f, "%.2f", ImGuiSliderFlags_AlwaysClamp); + if (ImGui::IsItemActive()) + { + ImGui::SetNextWindowPos(ImGui::GetCursorScreenPos()); + ImGui::BeginTooltip(); + ImGui::TextUnformatted("(R = radius, N = number of segments)"); + ImGui::Spacing(); + ImDrawList* draw_list = ImGui::GetWindowDrawList(); + const float min_widget_width = ImGui::CalcTextSize("N: MMM\nR: MMM").x; + for (int n = 0; n < 8; n++) + { + const float RAD_MIN = 5.0f; + const float RAD_MAX = 70.0f; + const float rad = RAD_MIN + (RAD_MAX - RAD_MIN) * (float)n / (8.0f - 1.0f); + + ImGui::BeginGroup(); + + ImGui::Text("R: %.f\nN: %d", rad, draw_list->_CalcCircleAutoSegmentCount(rad)); + + const float canvas_width = IM_MAX(min_widget_width, rad * 2.0f); + const float offset_x = floorf(canvas_width * 0.5f); + const float offset_y = floorf(RAD_MAX); + + const ImVec2 p1 = ImGui::GetCursorScreenPos(); + draw_list->AddCircle(ImVec2(p1.x + offset_x, p1.y + offset_y), rad, ImGui::GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text)); + ImGui::Dummy(ImVec2(canvas_width, RAD_MAX * 2)); + + /* + const ImVec2 p2 = ImGui::GetCursorScreenPos(); + draw_list->AddCircleFilled(ImVec2(p2.x + offset_x, p2.y + offset_y), rad, ImGui::GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text)); + ImGui::Dummy(ImVec2(canvas_width, RAD_MAX * 2)); + */ + + ImGui::EndGroup(); + ImGui::SameLine(); + } + ImGui::EndTooltip(); + } + ImGui::SameLine(); + HelpMarker("When drawing circle primitives with \"num_segments == 0\" tesselation will be calculated automatically."); + + ImGui::DragFloat("Global Alpha", &style.Alpha, 0.005f, 0.20f, 1.0f, "%.2f"); // Not exposing zero here so user doesn't "lose" the UI (zero alpha clips all widgets). But application code could have a toggle to switch between zero and non-zero. + ImGui::DragFloat("Disabled Alpha", &style.DisabledAlpha, 0.005f, 0.0f, 1.0f, "%.2f"); ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Additional alpha multiplier for disabled items (multiply over current value of Alpha)."); + ImGui::PopItemWidth(); + + ImGui::EndTabItem(); + } + + ImGui::EndTabBar(); + } + + ImGui::PopItemWidth(); +} + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Example App: Main Menu Bar / ShowExampleAppMainMenuBar() +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// - ShowExampleAppMainMenuBar() +// - ShowExampleMenuFile() +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// Demonstrate creating a "main" fullscreen menu bar and populating it. +// Note the difference between BeginMainMenuBar() and BeginMenuBar(): +// - BeginMenuBar() = menu-bar inside current window (which needs the ImGuiWindowFlags_MenuBar flag!) +// - BeginMainMenuBar() = helper to create menu-bar-sized window at the top of the main viewport + call BeginMenuBar() into it. +static void ShowExampleAppMainMenuBar() +{ + if (ImGui::BeginMainMenuBar()) + { + if (ImGui::BeginMenu("File")) + { + ShowExampleMenuFile(); + ImGui::EndMenu(); + } + if (ImGui::BeginMenu("Edit")) + { + if (ImGui::MenuItem("Undo", "CTRL+Z")) {} + if (ImGui::MenuItem("Redo", "CTRL+Y", false, false)) {} // Disabled item + ImGui::Separator(); + if (ImGui::MenuItem("Cut", "CTRL+X")) {} + if (ImGui::MenuItem("Copy", "CTRL+C")) {} + if (ImGui::MenuItem("Paste", "CTRL+V")) {} + ImGui::EndMenu(); + } + ImGui::EndMainMenuBar(); + } +} + +// Note that shortcuts are currently provided for display only +// (future version will add explicit flags to BeginMenu() to request processing shortcuts) +static void ShowExampleMenuFile() +{ + ImGui::MenuItem("(demo menu)", NULL, false, false); + if (ImGui::MenuItem("New")) {} + if (ImGui::MenuItem("Open", "Ctrl+O")) {} + if (ImGui::BeginMenu("Open Recent")) + { + ImGui::MenuItem("fish_hat.c"); + ImGui::MenuItem("fish_hat.inl"); + ImGui::MenuItem("fish_hat.h"); + if (ImGui::BeginMenu("More..")) + { + ImGui::MenuItem("Hello"); + ImGui::MenuItem("Sailor"); + if (ImGui::BeginMenu("Recurse..")) + { + ShowExampleMenuFile(); + ImGui::EndMenu(); + } + ImGui::EndMenu(); + } + ImGui::EndMenu(); + } + if (ImGui::MenuItem("Save", "Ctrl+S")) {} + if (ImGui::MenuItem("Save As..")) {} + + ImGui::Separator(); + if (ImGui::BeginMenu("Options")) + { + static bool enabled = true; + ImGui::MenuItem("Enabled", "", &enabled); + ImGui::BeginChild("child", ImVec2(0, 60), true); + for (int i = 0; i < 10; i++) + ImGui::Text("Scrolling Text %d", i); + ImGui::EndChild(); + static float f = 0.5f; + static int n = 0; + ImGui::SliderFloat("Value", &f, 0.0f, 1.0f); + ImGui::InputFloat("Input", &f, 0.1f); + ImGui::Combo("Combo", &n, "Yes\0No\0Maybe\0\0"); + ImGui::EndMenu(); + } + + if (ImGui::BeginMenu("Colors")) + { + float sz = ImGui::GetTextLineHeight(); + for (int i = 0; i < ImGuiCol_COUNT; i++) + { + const char* name = ImGui::GetStyleColorName((ImGuiCol)i); + ImVec2 p = ImGui::GetCursorScreenPos(); + ImGui::GetWindowDrawList()->AddRectFilled(p, ImVec2(p.x + sz, p.y + sz), ImGui::GetColorU32((ImGuiCol)i)); + ImGui::Dummy(ImVec2(sz, sz)); + ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::MenuItem(name); + } + ImGui::EndMenu(); + } + + // Here we demonstrate appending again to the "Options" menu (which we already created above) + // Of course in this demo it is a little bit silly that this function calls BeginMenu("Options") twice. + // In a real code-base using it would make senses to use this feature from very different code locations. + if (ImGui::BeginMenu("Options")) // <-- Append! + { + static bool b = true; + ImGui::Checkbox("SomeOption", &b); + ImGui::EndMenu(); + } + + if (ImGui::BeginMenu("Disabled", false)) // Disabled + { + IM_ASSERT(0); + } + if (ImGui::MenuItem("Checked", NULL, true)) {} + if (ImGui::MenuItem("Quit", "Alt+F4")) {} +} + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Example App: Debug Console / ShowExampleAppConsole() +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// Demonstrate creating a simple console window, with scrolling, filtering, completion and history. +// For the console example, we are using a more C++ like approach of declaring a class to hold both data and functions. +struct ExampleAppConsole +{ + char InputBuf[256]; + ImVector Items; + ImVector Commands; + ImVector History; + int HistoryPos; // -1: new line, 0..History.Size-1 browsing history. + ImGuiTextFilter Filter; + bool AutoScroll; + bool ScrollToBottom; + + ExampleAppConsole() + { + ClearLog(); + memset(InputBuf, 0, sizeof(InputBuf)); + HistoryPos = -1; + + // "CLASSIFY" is here to provide the test case where "C"+[tab] completes to "CL" and display multiple matches. + Commands.push_back("HELP"); + Commands.push_back("HISTORY"); + Commands.push_back("CLEAR"); + Commands.push_back("CLASSIFY"); + AutoScroll = true; + ScrollToBottom = false; + AddLog("Welcome to Dear ImGui!"); + } + ~ExampleAppConsole() + { + ClearLog(); + for (int i = 0; i < History.Size; i++) + free(History[i]); + } + + // Portable helpers + static int Stricmp(const char* s1, const char* s2) { int d; while ((d = toupper(*s2) - toupper(*s1)) == 0 && *s1) { s1++; s2++; } return d; } + static int Strnicmp(const char* s1, const char* s2, int n) { int d = 0; while (n > 0 && (d = toupper(*s2) - toupper(*s1)) == 0 && *s1) { s1++; s2++; n--; } return d; } + static char* Strdup(const char* s) { IM_ASSERT(s); size_t len = strlen(s) + 1; void* buf = malloc(len); IM_ASSERT(buf); return (char*)memcpy(buf, (const void*)s, len); } + static void Strtrim(char* s) { char* str_end = s + strlen(s); while (str_end > s && str_end[-1] == ' ') str_end--; *str_end = 0; } + + void ClearLog() + { + for (int i = 0; i < Items.Size; i++) + free(Items[i]); + Items.clear(); + } + + void AddLog(const char* fmt, ...) IM_FMTARGS(2) + { + // FIXME-OPT + char buf[1024]; + va_list args; + va_start(args, fmt); + vsnprintf(buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf), fmt, args); + buf[IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf)-1] = 0; + va_end(args); + Items.push_back(Strdup(buf)); + } + + void Draw(const char* title, bool* p_open) + { + ImGui::SetNextWindowSize(ImVec2(520, 600), ImGuiCond_FirstUseEver); + if (!ImGui::Begin(title, p_open)) + { + ImGui::End(); + return; + } + + // As a specific feature guaranteed by the library, after calling Begin() the last Item represent the title bar. + // So e.g. IsItemHovered() will return true when hovering the title bar. + // Here we create a context menu only available from the title bar. + if (ImGui::BeginPopupContextItem()) + { + if (ImGui::MenuItem("Close Console")) + *p_open = false; + ImGui::EndPopup(); + } + + ImGui::TextWrapped( + "This example implements a console with basic coloring, completion (TAB key) and history (Up/Down keys). A more elaborate " + "implementation may want to store entries along with extra data such as timestamp, emitter, etc."); + ImGui::TextWrapped("Enter 'HELP' for help."); + + // TODO: display items starting from the bottom + + if (ImGui::SmallButton("Add Debug Text")) { AddLog("%d some text", Items.Size); AddLog("some more text"); AddLog("display very important message here!"); } + ImGui::SameLine(); + if (ImGui::SmallButton("Add Debug Error")) { AddLog("[error] something went wrong"); } + ImGui::SameLine(); + if (ImGui::SmallButton("Clear")) { ClearLog(); } + ImGui::SameLine(); + bool copy_to_clipboard = ImGui::SmallButton("Copy"); + //static float t = 0.0f; if (ImGui::GetTime() - t > 0.02f) { t = ImGui::GetTime(); AddLog("Spam %f", t); } + + ImGui::Separator(); + + // Options menu + if (ImGui::BeginPopup("Options")) + { + ImGui::Checkbox("Auto-scroll", &AutoScroll); + ImGui::EndPopup(); + } + + // Options, Filter + if (ImGui::Button("Options")) + ImGui::OpenPopup("Options"); + ImGui::SameLine(); + Filter.Draw("Filter (\"incl,-excl\") (\"error\")", 180); + ImGui::Separator(); + + // Reserve enough left-over height for 1 separator + 1 input text + const float footer_height_to_reserve = ImGui::GetStyle().ItemSpacing.y + ImGui::GetFrameHeightWithSpacing(); + ImGui::BeginChild("ScrollingRegion", ImVec2(0, -footer_height_to_reserve), false, ImGuiWindowFlags_HorizontalScrollbar); + if (ImGui::BeginPopupContextWindow()) + { + if (ImGui::Selectable("Clear")) ClearLog(); + ImGui::EndPopup(); + } + + // Display every line as a separate entry so we can change their color or add custom widgets. + // If you only want raw text you can use ImGui::TextUnformatted(log.begin(), log.end()); + // NB- if you have thousands of entries this approach may be too inefficient and may require user-side clipping + // to only process visible items. The clipper will automatically measure the height of your first item and then + // "seek" to display only items in the visible area. + // To use the clipper we can replace your standard loop: + // for (int i = 0; i < Items.Size; i++) + // With: + // ImGuiListClipper clipper; + // clipper.Begin(Items.Size); + // while (clipper.Step()) + // for (int i = clipper.DisplayStart; i < clipper.DisplayEnd; i++) + // - That your items are evenly spaced (same height) + // - That you have cheap random access to your elements (you can access them given their index, + // without processing all the ones before) + // You cannot this code as-is if a filter is active because it breaks the 'cheap random-access' property. + // We would need random-access on the post-filtered list. + // A typical application wanting coarse clipping and filtering may want to pre-compute an array of indices + // or offsets of items that passed the filtering test, recomputing this array when user changes the filter, + // and appending newly elements as they are inserted. This is left as a task to the user until we can manage + // to improve this example code! + // If your items are of variable height: + // - Split them into same height items would be simpler and facilitate random-seeking into your list. + // - Consider using manual call to IsRectVisible() and skipping extraneous decoration from your items. + ImGui::PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_ItemSpacing, ImVec2(4, 1)); // Tighten spacing + if (copy_to_clipboard) + ImGui::LogToClipboard(); + for (int i = 0; i < Items.Size; i++) + { + const char* item = Items[i]; + if (!Filter.PassFilter(item)) + continue; + + // Normally you would store more information in your item than just a string. + // (e.g. make Items[] an array of structure, store color/type etc.) + ImVec4 color; + bool has_color = false; + if (strstr(item, "[error]")) { color = ImVec4(1.0f, 0.4f, 0.4f, 1.0f); has_color = true; } + else if (strncmp(item, "# ", 2) == 0) { color = ImVec4(1.0f, 0.8f, 0.6f, 1.0f); has_color = true; } + if (has_color) + ImGui::PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_Text, color); + ImGui::TextUnformatted(item); + if (has_color) + ImGui::PopStyleColor(); + } + if (copy_to_clipboard) + ImGui::LogFinish(); + + if (ScrollToBottom || (AutoScroll && ImGui::GetScrollY() >= ImGui::GetScrollMaxY())) + ImGui::SetScrollHereY(1.0f); + ScrollToBottom = false; + + ImGui::PopStyleVar(); + ImGui::EndChild(); + ImGui::Separator(); + + // Command-line + bool reclaim_focus = false; + ImGuiInputTextFlags input_text_flags = ImGuiInputTextFlags_EnterReturnsTrue | ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackCompletion | ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackHistory; + if (ImGui::InputText("Input", InputBuf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(InputBuf), input_text_flags, &TextEditCallbackStub, (void*)this)) + { + char* s = InputBuf; + Strtrim(s); + if (s[0]) + ExecCommand(s); + strcpy(s, ""); + reclaim_focus = true; + } + + // Auto-focus on window apparition + ImGui::SetItemDefaultFocus(); + if (reclaim_focus) + ImGui::SetKeyboardFocusHere(-1); // Auto focus previous widget + + ImGui::End(); + } + + void ExecCommand(const char* command_line) + { + AddLog("# %s\n", command_line); + + // Insert into history. First find match and delete it so it can be pushed to the back. + // This isn't trying to be smart or optimal. + HistoryPos = -1; + for (int i = History.Size - 1; i >= 0; i--) + if (Stricmp(History[i], command_line) == 0) + { + free(History[i]); + History.erase(History.begin() + i); + break; + } + History.push_back(Strdup(command_line)); + + // Process command + if (Stricmp(command_line, "CLEAR") == 0) + { + ClearLog(); + } + else if (Stricmp(command_line, "HELP") == 0) + { + AddLog("Commands:"); + for (int i = 0; i < Commands.Size; i++) + AddLog("- %s", Commands[i]); + } + else if (Stricmp(command_line, "HISTORY") == 0) + { + int first = History.Size - 10; + for (int i = first > 0 ? first : 0; i < History.Size; i++) + AddLog("%3d: %s\n", i, History[i]); + } + else + { + AddLog("Unknown command: '%s'\n", command_line); + } + + // On command input, we scroll to bottom even if AutoScroll==false + ScrollToBottom = true; + } + + // In C++11 you'd be better off using lambdas for this sort of forwarding callbacks + static int TextEditCallbackStub(ImGuiInputTextCallbackData* data) + { + ExampleAppConsole* console = (ExampleAppConsole*)data->UserData; + return console->TextEditCallback(data); + } + + int TextEditCallback(ImGuiInputTextCallbackData* data) + { + //AddLog("cursor: %d, selection: %d-%d", data->CursorPos, data->SelectionStart, data->SelectionEnd); + switch (data->EventFlag) + { + case ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackCompletion: + { + // Example of TEXT COMPLETION + + // Locate beginning of current word + const char* word_end = data->Buf + data->CursorPos; + const char* word_start = word_end; + while (word_start > data->Buf) + { + const char c = word_start[-1]; + if (c == ' ' || c == '\t' || c == ',' || c == ';') + break; + word_start--; + } + + // Build a list of candidates + ImVector candidates; + for (int i = 0; i < Commands.Size; i++) + if (Strnicmp(Commands[i], word_start, (int)(word_end - word_start)) == 0) + candidates.push_back(Commands[i]); + + if (candidates.Size == 0) + { + // No match + AddLog("No match for \"%.*s\"!\n", (int)(word_end - word_start), word_start); + } + else if (candidates.Size == 1) + { + // Single match. Delete the beginning of the word and replace it entirely so we've got nice casing. + data->DeleteChars((int)(word_start - data->Buf), (int)(word_end - word_start)); + data->InsertChars(data->CursorPos, candidates[0]); + data->InsertChars(data->CursorPos, " "); + } + else + { + // Multiple matches. Complete as much as we can.. + // So inputing "C"+Tab will complete to "CL" then display "CLEAR" and "CLASSIFY" as matches. + int match_len = (int)(word_end - word_start); + for (;;) + { + int c = 0; + bool all_candidates_matches = true; + for (int i = 0; i < candidates.Size && all_candidates_matches; i++) + if (i == 0) + c = toupper(candidates[i][match_len]); + else if (c == 0 || c != toupper(candidates[i][match_len])) + all_candidates_matches = false; + if (!all_candidates_matches) + break; + match_len++; + } + + if (match_len > 0) + { + data->DeleteChars((int)(word_start - data->Buf), (int)(word_end - word_start)); + data->InsertChars(data->CursorPos, candidates[0], candidates[0] + match_len); + } + + // List matches + AddLog("Possible matches:\n"); + for (int i = 0; i < candidates.Size; i++) + AddLog("- %s\n", candidates[i]); + } + + break; + } + case ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackHistory: + { + // Example of HISTORY + const int prev_history_pos = HistoryPos; + if (data->EventKey == ImGuiKey_UpArrow) + { + if (HistoryPos == -1) + HistoryPos = History.Size - 1; + else if (HistoryPos > 0) + HistoryPos--; + } + else if (data->EventKey == ImGuiKey_DownArrow) + { + if (HistoryPos != -1) + if (++HistoryPos >= History.Size) + HistoryPos = -1; + } + + // A better implementation would preserve the data on the current input line along with cursor position. + if (prev_history_pos != HistoryPos) + { + const char* history_str = (HistoryPos >= 0) ? History[HistoryPos] : ""; + data->DeleteChars(0, data->BufTextLen); + data->InsertChars(0, history_str); + } + } + } + return 0; + } +}; + +static void ShowExampleAppConsole(bool* p_open) +{ + static ExampleAppConsole console; + console.Draw("Example: Console", p_open); +} + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Example App: Debug Log / ShowExampleAppLog() +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// Usage: +// static ExampleAppLog my_log; +// my_log.AddLog("Hello %d world\n", 123); +// my_log.Draw("title"); +struct ExampleAppLog +{ + ImGuiTextBuffer Buf; + ImGuiTextFilter Filter; + ImVector LineOffsets; // Index to lines offset. We maintain this with AddLog() calls. + bool AutoScroll; // Keep scrolling if already at the bottom. + + ExampleAppLog() + { + AutoScroll = true; + Clear(); + } + + void Clear() + { + Buf.clear(); + LineOffsets.clear(); + LineOffsets.push_back(0); + } + + void AddLog(const char* fmt, ...) IM_FMTARGS(2) + { + int old_size = Buf.size(); + va_list args; + va_start(args, fmt); + Buf.appendfv(fmt, args); + va_end(args); + for (int new_size = Buf.size(); old_size < new_size; old_size++) + if (Buf[old_size] == '\n') + LineOffsets.push_back(old_size + 1); + } + + void Draw(const char* title, bool* p_open = NULL) + { + if (!ImGui::Begin(title, p_open)) + { + ImGui::End(); + return; + } + + // Options menu + if (ImGui::BeginPopup("Options")) + { + ImGui::Checkbox("Auto-scroll", &AutoScroll); + ImGui::EndPopup(); + } + + // Main window + if (ImGui::Button("Options")) + ImGui::OpenPopup("Options"); + ImGui::SameLine(); + bool clear = ImGui::Button("Clear"); + ImGui::SameLine(); + bool copy = ImGui::Button("Copy"); + ImGui::SameLine(); + Filter.Draw("Filter", -100.0f); + + ImGui::Separator(); + ImGui::BeginChild("scrolling", ImVec2(0, 0), false, ImGuiWindowFlags_HorizontalScrollbar); + + if (clear) + Clear(); + if (copy) + ImGui::LogToClipboard(); + + ImGui::PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_ItemSpacing, ImVec2(0, 0)); + const char* buf = Buf.begin(); + const char* buf_end = Buf.end(); + if (Filter.IsActive()) + { + // In this example we don't use the clipper when Filter is enabled. + // This is because we don't have a random access on the result on our filter. + // A real application processing logs with ten of thousands of entries may want to store the result of + // search/filter.. especially if the filtering function is not trivial (e.g. reg-exp). + for (int line_no = 0; line_no < LineOffsets.Size; line_no++) + { + const char* line_start = buf + LineOffsets[line_no]; + const char* line_end = (line_no + 1 < LineOffsets.Size) ? (buf + LineOffsets[line_no + 1] - 1) : buf_end; + if (Filter.PassFilter(line_start, line_end)) + ImGui::TextUnformatted(line_start, line_end); + } + } + else + { + // The simplest and easy way to display the entire buffer: + // ImGui::TextUnformatted(buf_begin, buf_end); + // And it'll just work. TextUnformatted() has specialization for large blob of text and will fast-forward + // to skip non-visible lines. Here we instead demonstrate using the clipper to only process lines that are + // within the visible area. + // If you have tens of thousands of items and their processing cost is non-negligible, coarse clipping them + // on your side is recommended. Using ImGuiListClipper requires + // - A) random access into your data + // - B) items all being the same height, + // both of which we can handle since we an array pointing to the beginning of each line of text. + // When using the filter (in the block of code above) we don't have random access into the data to display + // anymore, which is why we don't use the clipper. Storing or skimming through the search result would make + // it possible (and would be recommended if you want to search through tens of thousands of entries). + ImGuiListClipper clipper; + clipper.Begin(LineOffsets.Size); + while (clipper.Step()) + { + for (int line_no = clipper.DisplayStart; line_no < clipper.DisplayEnd; line_no++) + { + const char* line_start = buf + LineOffsets[line_no]; + const char* line_end = (line_no + 1 < LineOffsets.Size) ? (buf + LineOffsets[line_no + 1] - 1) : buf_end; + ImGui::TextUnformatted(line_start, line_end); + } + } + clipper.End(); + } + ImGui::PopStyleVar(); + + if (AutoScroll && ImGui::GetScrollY() >= ImGui::GetScrollMaxY()) + ImGui::SetScrollHereY(1.0f); + + ImGui::EndChild(); + ImGui::End(); + } +}; + +// Demonstrate creating a simple log window with basic filtering. +static void ShowExampleAppLog(bool* p_open) +{ + static ExampleAppLog log; + + // For the demo: add a debug button _BEFORE_ the normal log window contents + // We take advantage of a rarely used feature: multiple calls to Begin()/End() are appending to the _same_ window. + // Most of the contents of the window will be added by the log.Draw() call. + ImGui::SetNextWindowSize(ImVec2(500, 400), ImGuiCond_FirstUseEver); + ImGui::Begin("Example: Log", p_open); + if (ImGui::SmallButton("[Debug] Add 5 entries")) + { + static int counter = 0; + const char* categories[3] = { "info", "warn", "error" }; + const char* words[] = { "Bumfuzzled", "Cattywampus", "Snickersnee", "Abibliophobia", "Absquatulate", "Nincompoop", "Pauciloquent" }; + for (int n = 0; n < 5; n++) + { + const char* category = categories[counter % IM_ARRAYSIZE(categories)]; + const char* word = words[counter % IM_ARRAYSIZE(words)]; + log.AddLog("[%05d] [%s] Hello, current time is %.1f, here's a word: '%s'\n", + ImGui::GetFrameCount(), category, ImGui::GetTime(), word); + counter++; + } + } + ImGui::End(); + + // Actually call in the regular Log helper (which will Begin() into the same window as we just did) + log.Draw("Example: Log", p_open); +} + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Example App: Simple Layout / ShowExampleAppLayout() +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// Demonstrate create a window with multiple child windows. +static void ShowExampleAppLayout(bool* p_open) +{ + ImGui::SetNextWindowSize(ImVec2(500, 440), ImGuiCond_FirstUseEver); + if (ImGui::Begin("Example: Simple layout", p_open, ImGuiWindowFlags_MenuBar)) + { + if (ImGui::BeginMenuBar()) + { + if (ImGui::BeginMenu("File")) + { + if (ImGui::MenuItem("Close")) *p_open = false; + ImGui::EndMenu(); + } + ImGui::EndMenuBar(); + } + + // Left + static int selected = 0; + { + ImGui::BeginChild("left pane", ImVec2(150, 0), true); + for (int i = 0; i < 100; i++) + { + // FIXME: Good candidate to use ImGuiSelectableFlags_SelectOnNav + char label[128]; + sprintf(label, "MyObject %d", i); + if (ImGui::Selectable(label, selected == i)) + selected = i; + } + ImGui::EndChild(); + } + ImGui::SameLine(); + + // Right + { + ImGui::BeginGroup(); + ImGui::BeginChild("item view", ImVec2(0, -ImGui::GetFrameHeightWithSpacing())); // Leave room for 1 line below us + ImGui::Text("MyObject: %d", selected); + ImGui::Separator(); + if (ImGui::BeginTabBar("##Tabs", ImGuiTabBarFlags_None)) + { + if (ImGui::BeginTabItem("Description")) + { + ImGui::TextWrapped("Lorem ipsum dolor sit amet, consectetur adipiscing elit, sed do eiusmod tempor incididunt ut labore et dolore magna aliqua. "); + ImGui::EndTabItem(); + } + if (ImGui::BeginTabItem("Details")) + { + ImGui::Text("ID: 0123456789"); + ImGui::EndTabItem(); + } + ImGui::EndTabBar(); + } + ImGui::EndChild(); + if (ImGui::Button("Revert")) {} + ImGui::SameLine(); + if (ImGui::Button("Save")) {} + ImGui::EndGroup(); + } + } + ImGui::End(); +} + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Example App: Property Editor / ShowExampleAppPropertyEditor() +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +static void ShowPlaceholderObject(const char* prefix, int uid) +{ + // Use object uid as identifier. Most commonly you could also use the object pointer as a base ID. + ImGui::PushID(uid); + + // Text and Tree nodes are less high than framed widgets, using AlignTextToFramePadding() we add vertical spacing to make the tree lines equal high. + ImGui::TableNextRow(); + ImGui::TableSetColumnIndex(0); + ImGui::AlignTextToFramePadding(); + bool node_open = ImGui::TreeNode("Object", "%s_%u", prefix, uid); + ImGui::TableSetColumnIndex(1); + ImGui::Text("my sailor is rich"); + + if (node_open) + { + static float placeholder_members[8] = { 0.0f, 0.0f, 1.0f, 3.1416f, 100.0f, 999.0f }; + for (int i = 0; i < 8; i++) + { + ImGui::PushID(i); // Use field index as identifier. + if (i < 2) + { + ShowPlaceholderObject("Child", 424242); + } + else + { + // Here we use a TreeNode to highlight on hover (we could use e.g. Selectable as well) + ImGui::TableNextRow(); + ImGui::TableSetColumnIndex(0); + ImGui::AlignTextToFramePadding(); + ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags = ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Leaf | ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NoTreePushOnOpen | ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Bullet; + ImGui::TreeNodeEx("Field", flags, "Field_%d", i); + + ImGui::TableSetColumnIndex(1); + ImGui::SetNextItemWidth(-FLT_MIN); + if (i >= 5) + ImGui::InputFloat("##value", &placeholder_members[i], 1.0f); + else + ImGui::DragFloat("##value", &placeholder_members[i], 0.01f); + ImGui::NextColumn(); + } + ImGui::PopID(); + } + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + ImGui::PopID(); +} + +// Demonstrate create a simple property editor. +static void ShowExampleAppPropertyEditor(bool* p_open) +{ + ImGui::SetNextWindowSize(ImVec2(430, 450), ImGuiCond_FirstUseEver); + if (!ImGui::Begin("Example: Property editor", p_open)) + { + ImGui::End(); + return; + } + + HelpMarker( + "This example shows how you may implement a property editor using two columns.\n" + "All objects/fields data are dummies here.\n" + "Remember that in many simple cases, you can use ImGui::SameLine(xxx) to position\n" + "your cursor horizontally instead of using the Columns() API."); + + ImGui::PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_FramePadding, ImVec2(2, 2)); + if (ImGui::BeginTable("split", 2, ImGuiTableFlags_BordersOuter | ImGuiTableFlags_Resizable)) + { + // Iterate placeholder objects (all the same data) + for (int obj_i = 0; obj_i < 4; obj_i++) + { + ShowPlaceholderObject("Object", obj_i); + //ImGui::Separator(); + } + ImGui::EndTable(); + } + ImGui::PopStyleVar(); + ImGui::End(); +} + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Example App: Long Text / ShowExampleAppLongText() +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// Demonstrate/test rendering huge amount of text, and the incidence of clipping. +static void ShowExampleAppLongText(bool* p_open) +{ + ImGui::SetNextWindowSize(ImVec2(520, 600), ImGuiCond_FirstUseEver); + if (!ImGui::Begin("Example: Long text display", p_open)) + { + ImGui::End(); + return; + } + + static int test_type = 0; + static ImGuiTextBuffer log; + static int lines = 0; + ImGui::Text("Printing unusually long amount of text."); + ImGui::Combo("Test type", &test_type, + "Single call to TextUnformatted()\0" + "Multiple calls to Text(), clipped\0" + "Multiple calls to Text(), not clipped (slow)\0"); + ImGui::Text("Buffer contents: %d lines, %d bytes", lines, log.size()); + if (ImGui::Button("Clear")) { log.clear(); lines = 0; } + ImGui::SameLine(); + if (ImGui::Button("Add 1000 lines")) + { + for (int i = 0; i < 1000; i++) + log.appendf("%i The quick brown fox jumps over the lazy dog\n", lines + i); + lines += 1000; + } + ImGui::BeginChild("Log"); + switch (test_type) + { + case 0: + // Single call to TextUnformatted() with a big buffer + ImGui::TextUnformatted(log.begin(), log.end()); + break; + case 1: + { + // Multiple calls to Text(), manually coarsely clipped - demonstrate how to use the ImGuiListClipper helper. + ImGui::PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_ItemSpacing, ImVec2(0, 0)); + ImGuiListClipper clipper; + clipper.Begin(lines); + while (clipper.Step()) + for (int i = clipper.DisplayStart; i < clipper.DisplayEnd; i++) + ImGui::Text("%i The quick brown fox jumps over the lazy dog", i); + ImGui::PopStyleVar(); + break; + } + case 2: + // Multiple calls to Text(), not clipped (slow) + ImGui::PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_ItemSpacing, ImVec2(0, 0)); + for (int i = 0; i < lines; i++) + ImGui::Text("%i The quick brown fox jumps over the lazy dog", i); + ImGui::PopStyleVar(); + break; + } + ImGui::EndChild(); + ImGui::End(); +} + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Example App: Auto Resize / ShowExampleAppAutoResize() +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// Demonstrate creating a window which gets auto-resized according to its content. +static void ShowExampleAppAutoResize(bool* p_open) +{ + if (!ImGui::Begin("Example: Auto-resizing window", p_open, ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize)) + { + ImGui::End(); + return; + } + + static int lines = 10; + ImGui::TextUnformatted( + "Window will resize every-frame to the size of its content.\n" + "Note that you probably don't want to query the window size to\n" + "output your content because that would create a feedback loop."); + ImGui::SliderInt("Number of lines", &lines, 1, 20); + for (int i = 0; i < lines; i++) + ImGui::Text("%*sThis is line %d", i * 4, "", i); // Pad with space to extend size horizontally + ImGui::End(); +} + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Example App: Constrained Resize / ShowExampleAppConstrainedResize() +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// Demonstrate creating a window with custom resize constraints. +static void ShowExampleAppConstrainedResize(bool* p_open) +{ + struct CustomConstraints + { + // Helper functions to demonstrate programmatic constraints + static void Square(ImGuiSizeCallbackData* data) { data->DesiredSize.x = data->DesiredSize.y = IM_MAX(data->DesiredSize.x, data->DesiredSize.y); } + static void Step(ImGuiSizeCallbackData* data) { float step = (float)(int)(intptr_t)data->UserData; data->DesiredSize = ImVec2((int)(data->DesiredSize.x / step + 0.5f) * step, (int)(data->DesiredSize.y / step + 0.5f) * step); } + }; + + const char* test_desc[] = + { + "Resize vertical only", + "Resize horizontal only", + "Width > 100, Height > 100", + "Width 400-500", + "Height 400-500", + "Custom: Always Square", + "Custom: Fixed Steps (100)", + }; + + static bool auto_resize = false; + static int type = 0; + static int display_lines = 10; + if (type == 0) ImGui::SetNextWindowSizeConstraints(ImVec2(-1, 0), ImVec2(-1, FLT_MAX)); // Vertical only + if (type == 1) ImGui::SetNextWindowSizeConstraints(ImVec2(0, -1), ImVec2(FLT_MAX, -1)); // Horizontal only + if (type == 2) ImGui::SetNextWindowSizeConstraints(ImVec2(100, 100), ImVec2(FLT_MAX, FLT_MAX)); // Width > 100, Height > 100 + if (type == 3) ImGui::SetNextWindowSizeConstraints(ImVec2(400, -1), ImVec2(500, -1)); // Width 400-500 + if (type == 4) ImGui::SetNextWindowSizeConstraints(ImVec2(-1, 400), ImVec2(-1, 500)); // Height 400-500 + if (type == 5) ImGui::SetNextWindowSizeConstraints(ImVec2(0, 0), ImVec2(FLT_MAX, FLT_MAX), CustomConstraints::Square); // Always Square + if (type == 6) ImGui::SetNextWindowSizeConstraints(ImVec2(0, 0), ImVec2(FLT_MAX, FLT_MAX), CustomConstraints::Step, (void*)(intptr_t)100); // Fixed Step + + ImGuiWindowFlags flags = auto_resize ? ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize : 0; + if (ImGui::Begin("Example: Constrained Resize", p_open, flags)) + { + if (ImGui::Button("200x200")) { ImGui::SetWindowSize(ImVec2(200, 200)); } ImGui::SameLine(); + if (ImGui::Button("500x500")) { ImGui::SetWindowSize(ImVec2(500, 500)); } ImGui::SameLine(); + if (ImGui::Button("800x200")) { ImGui::SetWindowSize(ImVec2(800, 200)); } + ImGui::SetNextItemWidth(200); + ImGui::Combo("Constraint", &type, test_desc, IM_ARRAYSIZE(test_desc)); + ImGui::SetNextItemWidth(200); + ImGui::DragInt("Lines", &display_lines, 0.2f, 1, 100); + ImGui::Checkbox("Auto-resize", &auto_resize); + for (int i = 0; i < display_lines; i++) + ImGui::Text("%*sHello, sailor! Making this line long enough for the example.", i * 4, ""); + } + ImGui::End(); +} + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Example App: Simple overlay / ShowExampleAppSimpleOverlay() +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// Demonstrate creating a simple static window with no decoration +// + a context-menu to choose which corner of the screen to use. +static void ShowExampleAppSimpleOverlay(bool* p_open) +{ + static int corner = 0; + ImGuiIO& io = ImGui::GetIO(); + ImGuiWindowFlags window_flags = ImGuiWindowFlags_NoDecoration | ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoSavedSettings | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoFocusOnAppearing | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoNav; + if (corner != -1) + { + const float PAD = 10.0f; + const ImGuiViewport* viewport = ImGui::GetMainViewport(); + ImVec2 work_pos = viewport->WorkPos; // Use work area to avoid menu-bar/task-bar, if any! + ImVec2 work_size = viewport->WorkSize; + ImVec2 window_pos, window_pos_pivot; + window_pos.x = (corner & 1) ? (work_pos.x + work_size.x - PAD) : (work_pos.x + PAD); + window_pos.y = (corner & 2) ? (work_pos.y + work_size.y - PAD) : (work_pos.y + PAD); + window_pos_pivot.x = (corner & 1) ? 1.0f : 0.0f; + window_pos_pivot.y = (corner & 2) ? 1.0f : 0.0f; + ImGui::SetNextWindowPos(window_pos, ImGuiCond_Always, window_pos_pivot); + window_flags |= ImGuiWindowFlags_NoMove; + } + ImGui::SetNextWindowBgAlpha(0.35f); // Transparent background + if (ImGui::Begin("Example: Simple overlay", p_open, window_flags)) + { + ImGui::Text("Simple overlay\n" "in the corner of the screen.\n" "(right-click to change position)"); + ImGui::Separator(); + if (ImGui::IsMousePosValid()) + ImGui::Text("Mouse Position: (%.1f,%.1f)", io.MousePos.x, io.MousePos.y); + else + ImGui::Text("Mouse Position: "); + if (ImGui::BeginPopupContextWindow()) + { + if (ImGui::MenuItem("Custom", NULL, corner == -1)) corner = -1; + if (ImGui::MenuItem("Top-left", NULL, corner == 0)) corner = 0; + if (ImGui::MenuItem("Top-right", NULL, corner == 1)) corner = 1; + if (ImGui::MenuItem("Bottom-left", NULL, corner == 2)) corner = 2; + if (ImGui::MenuItem("Bottom-right", NULL, corner == 3)) corner = 3; + if (p_open && ImGui::MenuItem("Close")) *p_open = false; + ImGui::EndPopup(); + } + } + ImGui::End(); +} + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Example App: Fullscreen window / ShowExampleAppFullscreen() +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// Demonstrate creating a window covering the entire screen/viewport +static void ShowExampleAppFullscreen(bool* p_open) +{ + static bool use_work_area = true; + static ImGuiWindowFlags flags = ImGuiWindowFlags_NoDecoration | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoMove | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoResize | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoSavedSettings; + + // We demonstrate using the full viewport area or the work area (without menu-bars, task-bars etc.) + // Based on your use case you may want one of the other. + const ImGuiViewport* viewport = ImGui::GetMainViewport(); + ImGui::SetNextWindowPos(use_work_area ? viewport->WorkPos : viewport->Pos); + ImGui::SetNextWindowSize(use_work_area ? viewport->WorkSize : viewport->Size); + + if (ImGui::Begin("Example: Fullscreen window", p_open, flags)) + { + ImGui::Checkbox("Use work area instead of main area", &use_work_area); + ImGui::SameLine(); + HelpMarker("Main Area = entire viewport,\nWork Area = entire viewport minus sections used by the main menu bars, task bars etc.\n\nEnable the main-menu bar in Examples menu to see the difference."); + + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiWindowFlags_NoBackground", &flags, ImGuiWindowFlags_NoBackground); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiWindowFlags_NoDecoration", &flags, ImGuiWindowFlags_NoDecoration); + ImGui::Indent(); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar", &flags, ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiWindowFlags_NoCollapse", &flags, ImGuiWindowFlags_NoCollapse); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiWindowFlags_NoScrollbar", &flags, ImGuiWindowFlags_NoScrollbar); + ImGui::Unindent(); + + if (p_open && ImGui::Button("Close this window")) + *p_open = false; + } + ImGui::End(); +} + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Example App: Manipulating Window Titles / ShowExampleAppWindowTitles() +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// Demonstrate using "##" and "###" in identifiers to manipulate ID generation. +// This apply to all regular items as well. +// Read FAQ section "How can I have multiple widgets with the same label?" for details. +static void ShowExampleAppWindowTitles(bool*) +{ + const ImGuiViewport* viewport = ImGui::GetMainViewport(); + const ImVec2 base_pos = viewport->Pos; + + // By default, Windows are uniquely identified by their title. + // You can use the "##" and "###" markers to manipulate the display/ID. + + // Using "##" to display same title but have unique identifier. + ImGui::SetNextWindowPos(ImVec2(base_pos.x + 100, base_pos.y + 100), ImGuiCond_FirstUseEver); + ImGui::Begin("Same title as another window##1"); + ImGui::Text("This is window 1.\nMy title is the same as window 2, but my identifier is unique."); + ImGui::End(); + + ImGui::SetNextWindowPos(ImVec2(base_pos.x + 100, base_pos.y + 200), ImGuiCond_FirstUseEver); + ImGui::Begin("Same title as another window##2"); + ImGui::Text("This is window 2.\nMy title is the same as window 1, but my identifier is unique."); + ImGui::End(); + + // Using "###" to display a changing title but keep a static identifier "AnimatedTitle" + char buf[128]; + sprintf(buf, "Animated title %c %d###AnimatedTitle", "|/-\\"[(int)(ImGui::GetTime() / 0.25f) & 3], ImGui::GetFrameCount()); + ImGui::SetNextWindowPos(ImVec2(base_pos.x + 100, base_pos.y + 300), ImGuiCond_FirstUseEver); + ImGui::Begin(buf); + ImGui::Text("This window has a changing title."); + ImGui::End(); +} + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Example App: Custom Rendering using ImDrawList API / ShowExampleAppCustomRendering() +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// Demonstrate using the low-level ImDrawList to draw custom shapes. +static void ShowExampleAppCustomRendering(bool* p_open) +{ + if (!ImGui::Begin("Example: Custom rendering", p_open)) + { + ImGui::End(); + return; + } + + // Tip: If you do a lot of custom rendering, you probably want to use your own geometrical types and benefit of + // overloaded operators, etc. Define IM_VEC2_CLASS_EXTRA in imconfig.h to create implicit conversions between your + // types and ImVec2/ImVec4. Dear ImGui defines overloaded operators but they are internal to imgui.cpp and not + // exposed outside (to avoid messing with your types) In this example we are not using the maths operators! + + if (ImGui::BeginTabBar("##TabBar")) + { + if (ImGui::BeginTabItem("Primitives")) + { + ImGui::PushItemWidth(-ImGui::GetFontSize() * 15); + ImDrawList* draw_list = ImGui::GetWindowDrawList(); + + // Draw gradients + // (note that those are currently exacerbating our sRGB/Linear issues) + // Calling ImGui::GetColorU32() multiplies the given colors by the current Style Alpha, but you may pass the IM_COL32() directly as well.. + ImGui::Text("Gradients"); + ImVec2 gradient_size = ImVec2(ImGui::CalcItemWidth(), ImGui::GetFrameHeight()); + { + ImVec2 p0 = ImGui::GetCursorScreenPos(); + ImVec2 p1 = ImVec2(p0.x + gradient_size.x, p0.y + gradient_size.y); + ImU32 col_a = ImGui::GetColorU32(IM_COL32(0, 0, 0, 255)); + ImU32 col_b = ImGui::GetColorU32(IM_COL32(255, 255, 255, 255)); + draw_list->AddRectFilledMultiColor(p0, p1, col_a, col_b, col_b, col_a); + ImGui::InvisibleButton("##gradient1", gradient_size); + } + { + ImVec2 p0 = ImGui::GetCursorScreenPos(); + ImVec2 p1 = ImVec2(p0.x + gradient_size.x, p0.y + gradient_size.y); + ImU32 col_a = ImGui::GetColorU32(IM_COL32(0, 255, 0, 255)); + ImU32 col_b = ImGui::GetColorU32(IM_COL32(255, 0, 0, 255)); + draw_list->AddRectFilledMultiColor(p0, p1, col_a, col_b, col_b, col_a); + ImGui::InvisibleButton("##gradient2", gradient_size); + } + + // Draw a bunch of primitives + ImGui::Text("All primitives"); + static float sz = 36.0f; + static float thickness = 3.0f; + static int ngon_sides = 6; + static bool circle_segments_override = false; + static int circle_segments_override_v = 12; + static bool curve_segments_override = false; + static int curve_segments_override_v = 8; + static ImVec4 colf = ImVec4(1.0f, 1.0f, 0.4f, 1.0f); + ImGui::DragFloat("Size", &sz, 0.2f, 2.0f, 100.0f, "%.0f"); + ImGui::DragFloat("Thickness", &thickness, 0.05f, 1.0f, 8.0f, "%.02f"); + ImGui::SliderInt("N-gon sides", &ngon_sides, 3, 12); + ImGui::Checkbox("##circlesegmentoverride", &circle_segments_override); + ImGui::SameLine(0.0f, ImGui::GetStyle().ItemInnerSpacing.x); + circle_segments_override |= ImGui::SliderInt("Circle segments override", &circle_segments_override_v, 3, 40); + ImGui::Checkbox("##curvessegmentoverride", &curve_segments_override); + ImGui::SameLine(0.0f, ImGui::GetStyle().ItemInnerSpacing.x); + curve_segments_override |= ImGui::SliderInt("Curves segments override", &curve_segments_override_v, 3, 40); + ImGui::ColorEdit4("Color", &colf.x); + + const ImVec2 p = ImGui::GetCursorScreenPos(); + const ImU32 col = ImColor(colf); + const float spacing = 10.0f; + const ImDrawFlags corners_tl_br = ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersTopLeft | ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersBottomRight; + const float rounding = sz / 5.0f; + const int circle_segments = circle_segments_override ? circle_segments_override_v : 0; + const int curve_segments = curve_segments_override ? curve_segments_override_v : 0; + float x = p.x + 4.0f; + float y = p.y + 4.0f; + for (int n = 0; n < 2; n++) + { + // First line uses a thickness of 1.0f, second line uses the configurable thickness + float th = (n == 0) ? 1.0f : thickness; + draw_list->AddNgon(ImVec2(x + sz*0.5f, y + sz*0.5f), sz*0.5f, col, ngon_sides, th); x += sz + spacing; // N-gon + draw_list->AddCircle(ImVec2(x + sz*0.5f, y + sz*0.5f), sz*0.5f, col, circle_segments, th); x += sz + spacing; // Circle + draw_list->AddRect(ImVec2(x, y), ImVec2(x + sz, y + sz), col, 0.0f, ImDrawFlags_None, th); x += sz + spacing; // Square + draw_list->AddRect(ImVec2(x, y), ImVec2(x + sz, y + sz), col, rounding, ImDrawFlags_None, th); x += sz + spacing; // Square with all rounded corners + draw_list->AddRect(ImVec2(x, y), ImVec2(x + sz, y + sz), col, rounding, corners_tl_br, th); x += sz + spacing; // Square with two rounded corners + draw_list->AddTriangle(ImVec2(x+sz*0.5f,y), ImVec2(x+sz, y+sz-0.5f), ImVec2(x, y+sz-0.5f), col, th);x += sz + spacing; // Triangle + //draw_list->AddTriangle(ImVec2(x+sz*0.2f,y), ImVec2(x, y+sz-0.5f), ImVec2(x+sz*0.4f, y+sz-0.5f), col, th);x+= sz*0.4f + spacing; // Thin triangle + draw_list->AddLine(ImVec2(x, y), ImVec2(x + sz, y), col, th); x += sz + spacing; // Horizontal line (note: drawing a filled rectangle will be faster!) + draw_list->AddLine(ImVec2(x, y), ImVec2(x, y + sz), col, th); x += spacing; // Vertical line (note: drawing a filled rectangle will be faster!) + draw_list->AddLine(ImVec2(x, y), ImVec2(x + sz, y + sz), col, th); x += sz + spacing; // Diagonal line + + // Quadratic Bezier Curve (3 control points) + ImVec2 cp3[3] = { ImVec2(x, y + sz * 0.6f), ImVec2(x + sz * 0.5f, y - sz * 0.4f), ImVec2(x + sz, y + sz) }; + draw_list->AddBezierQuadratic(cp3[0], cp3[1], cp3[2], col, th, curve_segments); x += sz + spacing; + + // Cubic Bezier Curve (4 control points) + ImVec2 cp4[4] = { ImVec2(x, y), ImVec2(x + sz * 1.3f, y + sz * 0.3f), ImVec2(x + sz - sz * 1.3f, y + sz - sz * 0.3f), ImVec2(x + sz, y + sz) }; + draw_list->AddBezierCubic(cp4[0], cp4[1], cp4[2], cp4[3], col, th, curve_segments); + + x = p.x + 4; + y += sz + spacing; + } + draw_list->AddNgonFilled(ImVec2(x + sz * 0.5f, y + sz * 0.5f), sz*0.5f, col, ngon_sides); x += sz + spacing; // N-gon + draw_list->AddCircleFilled(ImVec2(x + sz*0.5f, y + sz*0.5f), sz*0.5f, col, circle_segments); x += sz + spacing; // Circle + draw_list->AddRectFilled(ImVec2(x, y), ImVec2(x + sz, y + sz), col); x += sz + spacing; // Square + draw_list->AddRectFilled(ImVec2(x, y), ImVec2(x + sz, y + sz), col, 10.0f); x += sz + spacing; // Square with all rounded corners + draw_list->AddRectFilled(ImVec2(x, y), ImVec2(x + sz, y + sz), col, 10.0f, corners_tl_br); x += sz + spacing; // Square with two rounded corners + draw_list->AddTriangleFilled(ImVec2(x+sz*0.5f,y), ImVec2(x+sz, y+sz-0.5f), ImVec2(x, y+sz-0.5f), col); x += sz + spacing; // Triangle + //draw_list->AddTriangleFilled(ImVec2(x+sz*0.2f,y), ImVec2(x, y+sz-0.5f), ImVec2(x+sz*0.4f, y+sz-0.5f), col); x += sz*0.4f + spacing; // Thin triangle + draw_list->AddRectFilled(ImVec2(x, y), ImVec2(x + sz, y + thickness), col); x += sz + spacing; // Horizontal line (faster than AddLine, but only handle integer thickness) + draw_list->AddRectFilled(ImVec2(x, y), ImVec2(x + thickness, y + sz), col); x += spacing * 2.0f;// Vertical line (faster than AddLine, but only handle integer thickness) + draw_list->AddRectFilled(ImVec2(x, y), ImVec2(x + 1, y + 1), col); x += sz; // Pixel (faster than AddLine) + draw_list->AddRectFilledMultiColor(ImVec2(x, y), ImVec2(x + sz, y + sz), IM_COL32(0, 0, 0, 255), IM_COL32(255, 0, 0, 255), IM_COL32(255, 255, 0, 255), IM_COL32(0, 255, 0, 255)); + + ImGui::Dummy(ImVec2((sz + spacing) * 10.2f, (sz + spacing) * 3.0f)); + ImGui::PopItemWidth(); + ImGui::EndTabItem(); + } + + if (ImGui::BeginTabItem("Canvas")) + { + static ImVector points; + static ImVec2 scrolling(0.0f, 0.0f); + static bool opt_enable_grid = true; + static bool opt_enable_context_menu = true; + static bool adding_line = false; + + ImGui::Checkbox("Enable grid", &opt_enable_grid); + ImGui::Checkbox("Enable context menu", &opt_enable_context_menu); + ImGui::Text("Mouse Left: drag to add lines,\nMouse Right: drag to scroll, click for context menu."); + + // Typically you would use a BeginChild()/EndChild() pair to benefit from a clipping region + own scrolling. + // Here we demonstrate that this can be replaced by simple offsetting + custom drawing + PushClipRect/PopClipRect() calls. + // To use a child window instead we could use, e.g: + // ImGui::PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_WindowPadding, ImVec2(0, 0)); // Disable padding + // ImGui::PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_ChildBg, IM_COL32(50, 50, 50, 255)); // Set a background color + // ImGui::BeginChild("canvas", ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f), true, ImGuiWindowFlags_NoMove); + // ImGui::PopStyleColor(); + // ImGui::PopStyleVar(); + // [...] + // ImGui::EndChild(); + + // Using InvisibleButton() as a convenience 1) it will advance the layout cursor and 2) allows us to use IsItemHovered()/IsItemActive() + ImVec2 canvas_p0 = ImGui::GetCursorScreenPos(); // ImDrawList API uses screen coordinates! + ImVec2 canvas_sz = ImGui::GetContentRegionAvail(); // Resize canvas to what's available + if (canvas_sz.x < 50.0f) canvas_sz.x = 50.0f; + if (canvas_sz.y < 50.0f) canvas_sz.y = 50.0f; + ImVec2 canvas_p1 = ImVec2(canvas_p0.x + canvas_sz.x, canvas_p0.y + canvas_sz.y); + + // Draw border and background color + ImGuiIO& io = ImGui::GetIO(); + ImDrawList* draw_list = ImGui::GetWindowDrawList(); + draw_list->AddRectFilled(canvas_p0, canvas_p1, IM_COL32(50, 50, 50, 255)); + draw_list->AddRect(canvas_p0, canvas_p1, IM_COL32(255, 255, 255, 255)); + + // This will catch our interactions + ImGui::InvisibleButton("canvas", canvas_sz, ImGuiButtonFlags_MouseButtonLeft | ImGuiButtonFlags_MouseButtonRight); + const bool is_hovered = ImGui::IsItemHovered(); // Hovered + const bool is_active = ImGui::IsItemActive(); // Held + const ImVec2 origin(canvas_p0.x + scrolling.x, canvas_p0.y + scrolling.y); // Lock scrolled origin + const ImVec2 mouse_pos_in_canvas(io.MousePos.x - origin.x, io.MousePos.y - origin.y); + + // Add first and second point + if (is_hovered && !adding_line && ImGui::IsMouseClicked(ImGuiMouseButton_Left)) + { + points.push_back(mouse_pos_in_canvas); + points.push_back(mouse_pos_in_canvas); + adding_line = true; + } + if (adding_line) + { + points.back() = mouse_pos_in_canvas; + if (!ImGui::IsMouseDown(ImGuiMouseButton_Left)) + adding_line = false; + } + + // Pan (we use a zero mouse threshold when there's no context menu) + // You may decide to make that threshold dynamic based on whether the mouse is hovering something etc. + const float mouse_threshold_for_pan = opt_enable_context_menu ? -1.0f : 0.0f; + if (is_active && ImGui::IsMouseDragging(ImGuiMouseButton_Right, mouse_threshold_for_pan)) + { + scrolling.x += io.MouseDelta.x; + scrolling.y += io.MouseDelta.y; + } + + // Context menu (under default mouse threshold) + ImVec2 drag_delta = ImGui::GetMouseDragDelta(ImGuiMouseButton_Right); + if (opt_enable_context_menu && ImGui::IsMouseReleased(ImGuiMouseButton_Right) && drag_delta.x == 0.0f && drag_delta.y == 0.0f) + ImGui::OpenPopupOnItemClick("context"); + if (ImGui::BeginPopup("context")) + { + if (adding_line) + points.resize(points.size() - 2); + adding_line = false; + if (ImGui::MenuItem("Remove one", NULL, false, points.Size > 0)) { points.resize(points.size() - 2); } + if (ImGui::MenuItem("Remove all", NULL, false, points.Size > 0)) { points.clear(); } + ImGui::EndPopup(); + } + + // Draw grid + all lines in the canvas + draw_list->PushClipRect(canvas_p0, canvas_p1, true); + if (opt_enable_grid) + { + const float GRID_STEP = 64.0f; + for (float x = fmodf(scrolling.x, GRID_STEP); x < canvas_sz.x; x += GRID_STEP) + draw_list->AddLine(ImVec2(canvas_p0.x + x, canvas_p0.y), ImVec2(canvas_p0.x + x, canvas_p1.y), IM_COL32(200, 200, 200, 40)); + for (float y = fmodf(scrolling.y, GRID_STEP); y < canvas_sz.y; y += GRID_STEP) + draw_list->AddLine(ImVec2(canvas_p0.x, canvas_p0.y + y), ImVec2(canvas_p1.x, canvas_p0.y + y), IM_COL32(200, 200, 200, 40)); + } + for (int n = 0; n < points.Size; n += 2) + draw_list->AddLine(ImVec2(origin.x + points[n].x, origin.y + points[n].y), ImVec2(origin.x + points[n + 1].x, origin.y + points[n + 1].y), IM_COL32(255, 255, 0, 255), 2.0f); + draw_list->PopClipRect(); + + ImGui::EndTabItem(); + } + + if (ImGui::BeginTabItem("BG/FG draw lists")) + { + static bool draw_bg = true; + static bool draw_fg = true; + ImGui::Checkbox("Draw in Background draw list", &draw_bg); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("The Background draw list will be rendered below every Dear ImGui windows."); + ImGui::Checkbox("Draw in Foreground draw list", &draw_fg); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("The Foreground draw list will be rendered over every Dear ImGui windows."); + ImVec2 window_pos = ImGui::GetWindowPos(); + ImVec2 window_size = ImGui::GetWindowSize(); + ImVec2 window_center = ImVec2(window_pos.x + window_size.x * 0.5f, window_pos.y + window_size.y * 0.5f); + if (draw_bg) + ImGui::GetBackgroundDrawList()->AddCircle(window_center, window_size.x * 0.6f, IM_COL32(255, 0, 0, 200), 0, 10 + 4); + if (draw_fg) + ImGui::GetForegroundDrawList()->AddCircle(window_center, window_size.y * 0.6f, IM_COL32(0, 255, 0, 200), 0, 10); + ImGui::EndTabItem(); + } + + ImGui::EndTabBar(); + } + + ImGui::End(); +} + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Example App: Documents Handling / ShowExampleAppDocuments() +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// Simplified structure to mimic a Document model +struct MyDocument +{ + const char* Name; // Document title + bool Open; // Set when open (we keep an array of all available documents to simplify demo code!) + bool OpenPrev; // Copy of Open from last update. + bool Dirty; // Set when the document has been modified + bool WantClose; // Set when the document + ImVec4 Color; // An arbitrary variable associated to the document + + MyDocument(const char* name, bool open = true, const ImVec4& color = ImVec4(1.0f, 1.0f, 1.0f, 1.0f)) + { + Name = name; + Open = OpenPrev = open; + Dirty = false; + WantClose = false; + Color = color; + } + void DoOpen() { Open = true; } + void DoQueueClose() { WantClose = true; } + void DoForceClose() { Open = false; Dirty = false; } + void DoSave() { Dirty = false; } + + // Display placeholder contents for the Document + static void DisplayContents(MyDocument* doc) + { + ImGui::PushID(doc); + ImGui::Text("Document \"%s\"", doc->Name); + ImGui::PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_Text, doc->Color); + ImGui::TextWrapped("Lorem ipsum dolor sit amet, consectetur adipiscing elit, sed do eiusmod tempor incididunt ut labore et dolore magna aliqua."); + ImGui::PopStyleColor(); + if (ImGui::Button("Modify", ImVec2(100, 0))) + doc->Dirty = true; + ImGui::SameLine(); + if (ImGui::Button("Save", ImVec2(100, 0))) + doc->DoSave(); + ImGui::ColorEdit3("color", &doc->Color.x); // Useful to test drag and drop and hold-dragged-to-open-tab behavior. + ImGui::PopID(); + } + + // Display context menu for the Document + static void DisplayContextMenu(MyDocument* doc) + { + if (!ImGui::BeginPopupContextItem()) + return; + + char buf[256]; + sprintf(buf, "Save %s", doc->Name); + if (ImGui::MenuItem(buf, "CTRL+S", false, doc->Open)) + doc->DoSave(); + if (ImGui::MenuItem("Close", "CTRL+W", false, doc->Open)) + doc->DoQueueClose(); + ImGui::EndPopup(); + } +}; + +struct ExampleAppDocuments +{ + ImVector Documents; + + ExampleAppDocuments() + { + Documents.push_back(MyDocument("Lettuce", true, ImVec4(0.4f, 0.8f, 0.4f, 1.0f))); + Documents.push_back(MyDocument("Eggplant", true, ImVec4(0.8f, 0.5f, 1.0f, 1.0f))); + Documents.push_back(MyDocument("Carrot", true, ImVec4(1.0f, 0.8f, 0.5f, 1.0f))); + Documents.push_back(MyDocument("Tomato", false, ImVec4(1.0f, 0.3f, 0.4f, 1.0f))); + Documents.push_back(MyDocument("A Rather Long Title", false)); + Documents.push_back(MyDocument("Some Document", false)); + } +}; + +// [Optional] Notify the system of Tabs/Windows closure that happened outside the regular tab interface. +// If a tab has been closed programmatically (aka closed from another source such as the Checkbox() in the demo, +// as opposed to clicking on the regular tab closing button) and stops being submitted, it will take a frame for +// the tab bar to notice its absence. During this frame there will be a gap in the tab bar, and if the tab that has +// disappeared was the selected one, the tab bar will report no selected tab during the frame. This will effectively +// give the impression of a flicker for one frame. +// We call SetTabItemClosed() to manually notify the Tab Bar or Docking system of removed tabs to avoid this glitch. +// Note that this completely optional, and only affect tab bars with the ImGuiTabBarFlags_Reorderable flag. +static void NotifyOfDocumentsClosedElsewhere(ExampleAppDocuments& app) +{ + for (int doc_n = 0; doc_n < app.Documents.Size; doc_n++) + { + MyDocument* doc = &app.Documents[doc_n]; + if (!doc->Open && doc->OpenPrev) + ImGui::SetTabItemClosed(doc->Name); + doc->OpenPrev = doc->Open; + } +} + +void ShowExampleAppDocuments(bool* p_open) +{ + static ExampleAppDocuments app; + + // Options + static bool opt_reorderable = true; + static ImGuiTabBarFlags opt_fitting_flags = ImGuiTabBarFlags_FittingPolicyDefault_; + + bool window_contents_visible = ImGui::Begin("Example: Documents", p_open, ImGuiWindowFlags_MenuBar); + if (!window_contents_visible) + { + ImGui::End(); + return; + } + + // Menu + if (ImGui::BeginMenuBar()) + { + if (ImGui::BeginMenu("File")) + { + int open_count = 0; + for (int doc_n = 0; doc_n < app.Documents.Size; doc_n++) + open_count += app.Documents[doc_n].Open ? 1 : 0; + + if (ImGui::BeginMenu("Open", open_count < app.Documents.Size)) + { + for (int doc_n = 0; doc_n < app.Documents.Size; doc_n++) + { + MyDocument* doc = &app.Documents[doc_n]; + if (!doc->Open) + if (ImGui::MenuItem(doc->Name)) + doc->DoOpen(); + } + ImGui::EndMenu(); + } + if (ImGui::MenuItem("Close All Documents", NULL, false, open_count > 0)) + for (int doc_n = 0; doc_n < app.Documents.Size; doc_n++) + app.Documents[doc_n].DoQueueClose(); + if (ImGui::MenuItem("Exit", "Alt+F4")) {} + ImGui::EndMenu(); + } + ImGui::EndMenuBar(); + } + + // [Debug] List documents with one checkbox for each + for (int doc_n = 0; doc_n < app.Documents.Size; doc_n++) + { + MyDocument* doc = &app.Documents[doc_n]; + if (doc_n > 0) + ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::PushID(doc); + if (ImGui::Checkbox(doc->Name, &doc->Open)) + if (!doc->Open) + doc->DoForceClose(); + ImGui::PopID(); + } + + ImGui::Separator(); + + // About the ImGuiWindowFlags_UnsavedDocument / ImGuiTabItemFlags_UnsavedDocument flags. + // They have multiple effects: + // - Display a dot next to the title. + // - Tab is selected when clicking the X close button. + // - Closure is not assumed (will wait for user to stop submitting the tab). + // Otherwise closure is assumed when pressing the X, so if you keep submitting the tab may reappear at end of tab bar. + // We need to assume closure by default otherwise waiting for "lack of submission" on the next frame would leave an empty + // hole for one-frame, both in the tab-bar and in tab-contents when closing a tab/window. + // The rarely used SetTabItemClosed() function is a way to notify of programmatic closure to avoid the one-frame hole. + + // Submit Tab Bar and Tabs + { + ImGuiTabBarFlags tab_bar_flags = (opt_fitting_flags) | (opt_reorderable ? ImGuiTabBarFlags_Reorderable : 0); + if (ImGui::BeginTabBar("##tabs", tab_bar_flags)) + { + if (opt_reorderable) + NotifyOfDocumentsClosedElsewhere(app); + + // [DEBUG] Stress tests + //if ((ImGui::GetFrameCount() % 30) == 0) docs[1].Open ^= 1; // [DEBUG] Automatically show/hide a tab. Test various interactions e.g. dragging with this on. + //if (ImGui::GetIO().KeyCtrl) ImGui::SetTabItemSelected(docs[1].Name); // [DEBUG] Test SetTabItemSelected(), probably not very useful as-is anyway.. + + // Submit Tabs + for (int doc_n = 0; doc_n < app.Documents.Size; doc_n++) + { + MyDocument* doc = &app.Documents[doc_n]; + if (!doc->Open) + continue; + + ImGuiTabItemFlags tab_flags = (doc->Dirty ? ImGuiTabItemFlags_UnsavedDocument : 0); + bool visible = ImGui::BeginTabItem(doc->Name, &doc->Open, tab_flags); + + // Cancel attempt to close when unsaved add to save queue so we can display a popup. + if (!doc->Open && doc->Dirty) + { + doc->Open = true; + doc->DoQueueClose(); + } + + MyDocument::DisplayContextMenu(doc); + if (visible) + { + MyDocument::DisplayContents(doc); + ImGui::EndTabItem(); + } + } + + ImGui::EndTabBar(); + } + } + + // Update closing queue + static ImVector close_queue; + if (close_queue.empty()) + { + // Close queue is locked once we started a popup + for (int doc_n = 0; doc_n < app.Documents.Size; doc_n++) + { + MyDocument* doc = &app.Documents[doc_n]; + if (doc->WantClose) + { + doc->WantClose = false; + close_queue.push_back(doc); + } + } + } + + // Display closing confirmation UI + if (!close_queue.empty()) + { + int close_queue_unsaved_documents = 0; + for (int n = 0; n < close_queue.Size; n++) + if (close_queue[n]->Dirty) + close_queue_unsaved_documents++; + + if (close_queue_unsaved_documents == 0) + { + // Close documents when all are unsaved + for (int n = 0; n < close_queue.Size; n++) + close_queue[n]->DoForceClose(); + close_queue.clear(); + } + else + { + if (!ImGui::IsPopupOpen("Save?")) + ImGui::OpenPopup("Save?"); + if (ImGui::BeginPopupModal("Save?", NULL, ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize)) + { + ImGui::Text("Save change to the following items?"); + float item_height = ImGui::GetTextLineHeightWithSpacing(); + if (ImGui::BeginChildFrame(ImGui::GetID("frame"), ImVec2(-FLT_MIN, 6.25f * item_height))) + { + for (int n = 0; n < close_queue.Size; n++) + if (close_queue[n]->Dirty) + ImGui::Text("%s", close_queue[n]->Name); + ImGui::EndChildFrame(); + } + + ImVec2 button_size(ImGui::GetFontSize() * 7.0f, 0.0f); + if (ImGui::Button("Yes", button_size)) + { + for (int n = 0; n < close_queue.Size; n++) + { + if (close_queue[n]->Dirty) + close_queue[n]->DoSave(); + close_queue[n]->DoForceClose(); + } + close_queue.clear(); + ImGui::CloseCurrentPopup(); + } + ImGui::SameLine(); + if (ImGui::Button("No", button_size)) + { + for (int n = 0; n < close_queue.Size; n++) + close_queue[n]->DoForceClose(); + close_queue.clear(); + ImGui::CloseCurrentPopup(); + } + ImGui::SameLine(); + if (ImGui::Button("Cancel", button_size)) + { + close_queue.clear(); + ImGui::CloseCurrentPopup(); + } + ImGui::EndPopup(); + } + } + } + + ImGui::End(); +} + +// End of Demo code +#else + +void ImGui::ShowAboutWindow(bool*) {} +void ImGui::ShowDemoWindow(bool*) {} +void ImGui::ShowUserGuide() {} +void ImGui::ShowStyleEditor(ImGuiStyle*) {} + +#endif + +#endif // #ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE diff --git a/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/imgui-1.84.2/imgui_draw.cpp b/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/imgui-1.84.2/imgui_draw.cpp new file mode 100644 index 0000000..e1d7b7e --- /dev/null +++ b/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/imgui-1.84.2/imgui_draw.cpp @@ -0,0 +1,4177 @@ +// dear imgui, v1.84 +// (drawing and font code) + +/* + +Index of this file: + +// [SECTION] STB libraries implementation +// [SECTION] Style functions +// [SECTION] ImDrawList +// [SECTION] ImDrawListSplitter +// [SECTION] ImDrawData +// [SECTION] Helpers ShadeVertsXXX functions +// [SECTION] ImFontConfig +// [SECTION] ImFontAtlas +// [SECTION] ImFontAtlas glyph ranges helpers +// [SECTION] ImFontGlyphRangesBuilder +// [SECTION] ImFont +// [SECTION] ImGui Internal Render Helpers +// [SECTION] Decompression code +// [SECTION] Default font data (ProggyClean.ttf) + +*/ + +#if defined(_MSC_VER) && !defined(_CRT_SECURE_NO_WARNINGS) +#define _CRT_SECURE_NO_WARNINGS +#endif + +#include "imgui.h" +#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE + +#ifndef IMGUI_DEFINE_MATH_OPERATORS +#define IMGUI_DEFINE_MATH_OPERATORS +#endif + +#include "imgui_internal.h" +#ifdef IMGUI_ENABLE_FREETYPE +#include "misc/freetype/imgui_freetype.h" +#endif + +#include // vsnprintf, sscanf, printf +#if !defined(alloca) +#if defined(__GLIBC__) || defined(__sun) || defined(__APPLE__) || defined(__NEWLIB__) +#include // alloca (glibc uses . Note that Cygwin may have _WIN32 defined, so the order matters here) +#elif defined(_WIN32) +#include // alloca +#if !defined(alloca) +#define alloca _alloca // for clang with MS Codegen +#endif +#else +#include // alloca +#endif +#endif + +// Visual Studio warnings +#ifdef _MSC_VER +#pragma warning (disable: 4127) // condition expression is constant +#pragma warning (disable: 4505) // unreferenced local function has been removed (stb stuff) +#pragma warning (disable: 4996) // 'This function or variable may be unsafe': strcpy, strdup, sprintf, vsnprintf, sscanf, fopen +#pragma warning (disable: 6255) // [Static Analyzer] _alloca indicates failure by raising a stack overflow exception. Consider using _malloca instead. +#pragma warning (disable: 26451) // [Static Analyzer] Arithmetic overflow : Using operator 'xxx' on a 4 byte value and then casting the result to a 8 byte value. Cast the value to the wider type before calling operator 'xxx' to avoid overflow(io.2). +#pragma warning (disable: 26812) // [Static Analyzer] The enum type 'xxx' is unscoped. Prefer 'enum class' over 'enum' (Enum.3). [MSVC Static Analyzer) +#endif + +// Clang/GCC warnings with -Weverything +#if defined(__clang__) +#if __has_warning("-Wunknown-warning-option") +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wunknown-warning-option" // warning: unknown warning group 'xxx' // not all warnings are known by all Clang versions and they tend to be rename-happy.. so ignoring warnings triggers new warnings on some configuration. Great! +#endif +#if __has_warning("-Walloca") +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Walloca" // warning: use of function '__builtin_alloca' is discouraged +#endif +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wunknown-pragmas" // warning: unknown warning group 'xxx' +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wold-style-cast" // warning: use of old-style cast // yes, they are more terse. +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wfloat-equal" // warning: comparing floating point with == or != is unsafe // storing and comparing against same constants ok. +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wglobal-constructors" // warning: declaration requires a global destructor // similar to above, not sure what the exact difference is. +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wsign-conversion" // warning: implicit conversion changes signedness +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wzero-as-null-pointer-constant" // warning: zero as null pointer constant // some standard header variations use #define NULL 0 +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wcomma" // warning: possible misuse of comma operator here +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wreserved-id-macro" // warning: macro name is a reserved identifier +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wdouble-promotion" // warning: implicit conversion from 'float' to 'double' when passing argument to function // using printf() is a misery with this as C++ va_arg ellipsis changes float to double. +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wimplicit-int-float-conversion" // warning: implicit conversion from 'xxx' to 'float' may lose precision +#elif defined(__GNUC__) +#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wpragmas" // warning: unknown option after '#pragma GCC diagnostic' kind +#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wunused-function" // warning: 'xxxx' defined but not used +#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wdouble-promotion" // warning: implicit conversion from 'float' to 'double' when passing argument to function +#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wconversion" // warning: conversion to 'xxxx' from 'xxxx' may alter its value +#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wstack-protector" // warning: stack protector not protecting local variables: variable length buffer +#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wclass-memaccess" // [__GNUC__ >= 8] warning: 'memset/memcpy' clearing/writing an object of type 'xxxx' with no trivial copy-assignment; use assignment or value-initialization instead +#endif + +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] STB libraries implementation +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// Compile time options: +//#define IMGUI_STB_NAMESPACE ImStb +//#define IMGUI_STB_TRUETYPE_FILENAME "my_folder/stb_truetype.h" +//#define IMGUI_STB_RECT_PACK_FILENAME "my_folder/stb_rect_pack.h" +//#define IMGUI_DISABLE_STB_TRUETYPE_IMPLEMENTATION +//#define IMGUI_DISABLE_STB_RECT_PACK_IMPLEMENTATION + +#ifdef IMGUI_STB_NAMESPACE +namespace IMGUI_STB_NAMESPACE +{ +#endif + +#ifdef _MSC_VER +#pragma warning (push) +#pragma warning (disable: 4456) // declaration of 'xx' hides previous local declaration +#pragma warning (disable: 6011) // (stb_rectpack) Dereferencing NULL pointer 'cur->next'. +#pragma warning (disable: 6385) // (stb_truetype) Reading invalid data from 'buffer': the readable size is '_Old_3`kernel_width' bytes, but '3' bytes may be read. +#pragma warning (disable: 28182) // (stb_rectpack) Dereferencing NULL pointer. 'cur' contains the same NULL value as 'cur->next' did. +#endif + +#if defined(__clang__) +#pragma clang diagnostic push +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wunused-function" +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wmissing-prototypes" +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wimplicit-fallthrough" +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wcast-qual" // warning: cast from 'const xxxx *' to 'xxx *' drops const qualifier +#endif + +#if defined(__GNUC__) +#pragma GCC diagnostic push +#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wtype-limits" // warning: comparison is always true due to limited range of data type [-Wtype-limits] +#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wcast-qual" // warning: cast from type 'const xxxx *' to type 'xxxx *' casts away qualifiers +#endif + +#ifndef STB_RECT_PACK_IMPLEMENTATION // in case the user already have an implementation in the _same_ compilation unit (e.g. unity builds) +#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_STB_RECT_PACK_IMPLEMENTATION // in case the user already have an implementation in another compilation unit +#define STBRP_STATIC +#define STBRP_ASSERT(x) do { IM_ASSERT(x); } while (0) +#define STBRP_SORT ImQsort +#define STB_RECT_PACK_IMPLEMENTATION +#endif +#ifdef IMGUI_STB_RECT_PACK_FILENAME +#include IMGUI_STB_RECT_PACK_FILENAME +#else +#include "imstb_rectpack.h" +#endif +#endif + +#ifdef IMGUI_ENABLE_STB_TRUETYPE +#ifndef STB_TRUETYPE_IMPLEMENTATION // in case the user already have an implementation in the _same_ compilation unit (e.g. unity builds) +#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_STB_TRUETYPE_IMPLEMENTATION // in case the user already have an implementation in another compilation unit +#define STBTT_malloc(x,u) ((void)(u), IM_ALLOC(x)) +#define STBTT_free(x,u) ((void)(u), IM_FREE(x)) +#define STBTT_assert(x) do { IM_ASSERT(x); } while(0) +#define STBTT_fmod(x,y) ImFmod(x,y) +#define STBTT_sqrt(x) ImSqrt(x) +#define STBTT_pow(x,y) ImPow(x,y) +#define STBTT_fabs(x) ImFabs(x) +#define STBTT_ifloor(x) ((int)ImFloorSigned(x)) +#define STBTT_iceil(x) ((int)ImCeil(x)) +#define STBTT_STATIC +#define STB_TRUETYPE_IMPLEMENTATION +#else +#define STBTT_DEF extern +#endif +#ifdef IMGUI_STB_TRUETYPE_FILENAME +#include IMGUI_STB_TRUETYPE_FILENAME +#else +#include "imstb_truetype.h" +#endif +#endif +#endif // IMGUI_ENABLE_STB_TRUETYPE + +#if defined(__GNUC__) +#pragma GCC diagnostic pop +#endif + +#if defined(__clang__) +#pragma clang diagnostic pop +#endif + +#if defined(_MSC_VER) +#pragma warning (pop) +#endif + +#ifdef IMGUI_STB_NAMESPACE +} // namespace ImStb +using namespace IMGUI_STB_NAMESPACE; +#endif + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Style functions +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +void ImGui::StyleColorsDark(ImGuiStyle* dst) +{ + ImGuiStyle* style = dst ? dst : &ImGui::GetStyle(); + ImVec4* colors = style->Colors; + + colors[ImGuiCol_Text] = ImVec4(1.00f, 1.00f, 1.00f, 1.00f); + colors[ImGuiCol_TextDisabled] = ImVec4(0.50f, 0.50f, 0.50f, 1.00f); + colors[ImGuiCol_WindowBg] = ImVec4(0.06f, 0.06f, 0.06f, 0.94f); + colors[ImGuiCol_ChildBg] = ImVec4(0.00f, 0.00f, 0.00f, 0.00f); + colors[ImGuiCol_PopupBg] = ImVec4(0.08f, 0.08f, 0.08f, 0.94f); + colors[ImGuiCol_Border] = ImVec4(0.43f, 0.43f, 0.50f, 0.50f); + colors[ImGuiCol_BorderShadow] = ImVec4(0.00f, 0.00f, 0.00f, 0.00f); + colors[ImGuiCol_FrameBg] = ImVec4(0.16f, 0.29f, 0.48f, 0.54f); + colors[ImGuiCol_FrameBgHovered] = ImVec4(0.26f, 0.59f, 0.98f, 0.40f); + colors[ImGuiCol_FrameBgActive] = ImVec4(0.26f, 0.59f, 0.98f, 0.67f); + colors[ImGuiCol_TitleBg] = ImVec4(0.04f, 0.04f, 0.04f, 1.00f); + colors[ImGuiCol_TitleBgActive] = ImVec4(0.16f, 0.29f, 0.48f, 1.00f); + colors[ImGuiCol_TitleBgCollapsed] = ImVec4(0.00f, 0.00f, 0.00f, 0.51f); + colors[ImGuiCol_MenuBarBg] = ImVec4(0.14f, 0.14f, 0.14f, 1.00f); + colors[ImGuiCol_ScrollbarBg] = ImVec4(0.02f, 0.02f, 0.02f, 0.53f); + colors[ImGuiCol_ScrollbarGrab] = ImVec4(0.31f, 0.31f, 0.31f, 1.00f); + colors[ImGuiCol_ScrollbarGrabHovered] = ImVec4(0.41f, 0.41f, 0.41f, 1.00f); + colors[ImGuiCol_ScrollbarGrabActive] = ImVec4(0.51f, 0.51f, 0.51f, 1.00f); + colors[ImGuiCol_CheckMark] = ImVec4(0.26f, 0.59f, 0.98f, 1.00f); + colors[ImGuiCol_SliderGrab] = ImVec4(0.24f, 0.52f, 0.88f, 1.00f); + colors[ImGuiCol_SliderGrabActive] = ImVec4(0.26f, 0.59f, 0.98f, 1.00f); + colors[ImGuiCol_Button] = ImVec4(0.26f, 0.59f, 0.98f, 0.40f); + colors[ImGuiCol_ButtonHovered] = ImVec4(0.26f, 0.59f, 0.98f, 1.00f); + colors[ImGuiCol_ButtonActive] = ImVec4(0.06f, 0.53f, 0.98f, 1.00f); + colors[ImGuiCol_Header] = ImVec4(0.26f, 0.59f, 0.98f, 0.31f); + colors[ImGuiCol_HeaderHovered] = ImVec4(0.26f, 0.59f, 0.98f, 0.80f); + colors[ImGuiCol_HeaderActive] = ImVec4(0.26f, 0.59f, 0.98f, 1.00f); + colors[ImGuiCol_Separator] = colors[ImGuiCol_Border]; + colors[ImGuiCol_SeparatorHovered] = ImVec4(0.10f, 0.40f, 0.75f, 0.78f); + colors[ImGuiCol_SeparatorActive] = ImVec4(0.10f, 0.40f, 0.75f, 1.00f); + colors[ImGuiCol_ResizeGrip] = ImVec4(0.26f, 0.59f, 0.98f, 0.20f); + colors[ImGuiCol_ResizeGripHovered] = ImVec4(0.26f, 0.59f, 0.98f, 0.67f); + colors[ImGuiCol_ResizeGripActive] = ImVec4(0.26f, 0.59f, 0.98f, 0.95f); + colors[ImGuiCol_Tab] = ImLerp(colors[ImGuiCol_Header], colors[ImGuiCol_TitleBgActive], 0.80f); + colors[ImGuiCol_TabHovered] = colors[ImGuiCol_HeaderHovered]; + colors[ImGuiCol_TabActive] = ImLerp(colors[ImGuiCol_HeaderActive], colors[ImGuiCol_TitleBgActive], 0.60f); + colors[ImGuiCol_TabUnfocused] = ImLerp(colors[ImGuiCol_Tab], colors[ImGuiCol_TitleBg], 0.80f); + colors[ImGuiCol_TabUnfocusedActive] = ImLerp(colors[ImGuiCol_TabActive], colors[ImGuiCol_TitleBg], 0.40f); + colors[ImGuiCol_PlotLines] = ImVec4(0.61f, 0.61f, 0.61f, 1.00f); + colors[ImGuiCol_PlotLinesHovered] = ImVec4(1.00f, 0.43f, 0.35f, 1.00f); + colors[ImGuiCol_PlotHistogram] = ImVec4(0.90f, 0.70f, 0.00f, 1.00f); + colors[ImGuiCol_PlotHistogramHovered] = ImVec4(1.00f, 0.60f, 0.00f, 1.00f); + colors[ImGuiCol_TableHeaderBg] = ImVec4(0.19f, 0.19f, 0.20f, 1.00f); + colors[ImGuiCol_TableBorderStrong] = ImVec4(0.31f, 0.31f, 0.35f, 1.00f); // Prefer using Alpha=1.0 here + colors[ImGuiCol_TableBorderLight] = ImVec4(0.23f, 0.23f, 0.25f, 1.00f); // Prefer using Alpha=1.0 here + colors[ImGuiCol_TableRowBg] = ImVec4(0.00f, 0.00f, 0.00f, 0.00f); + colors[ImGuiCol_TableRowBgAlt] = ImVec4(1.00f, 1.00f, 1.00f, 0.06f); + colors[ImGuiCol_TextSelectedBg] = ImVec4(0.26f, 0.59f, 0.98f, 0.35f); + colors[ImGuiCol_DragDropTarget] = ImVec4(1.00f, 1.00f, 0.00f, 0.90f); + colors[ImGuiCol_NavHighlight] = ImVec4(0.26f, 0.59f, 0.98f, 1.00f); + colors[ImGuiCol_NavWindowingHighlight] = ImVec4(1.00f, 1.00f, 1.00f, 0.70f); + colors[ImGuiCol_NavWindowingDimBg] = ImVec4(0.80f, 0.80f, 0.80f, 0.20f); + colors[ImGuiCol_ModalWindowDimBg] = ImVec4(0.80f, 0.80f, 0.80f, 0.35f); +} + +void ImGui::StyleColorsClassic(ImGuiStyle* dst) +{ + ImGuiStyle* style = dst ? dst : &ImGui::GetStyle(); + ImVec4* colors = style->Colors; + + colors[ImGuiCol_Text] = ImVec4(0.90f, 0.90f, 0.90f, 1.00f); + colors[ImGuiCol_TextDisabled] = ImVec4(0.60f, 0.60f, 0.60f, 1.00f); + colors[ImGuiCol_WindowBg] = ImVec4(0.00f, 0.00f, 0.00f, 0.85f); + colors[ImGuiCol_ChildBg] = ImVec4(0.00f, 0.00f, 0.00f, 0.00f); + colors[ImGuiCol_PopupBg] = ImVec4(0.11f, 0.11f, 0.14f, 0.92f); + colors[ImGuiCol_Border] = ImVec4(0.50f, 0.50f, 0.50f, 0.50f); + colors[ImGuiCol_BorderShadow] = ImVec4(0.00f, 0.00f, 0.00f, 0.00f); + colors[ImGuiCol_FrameBg] = ImVec4(0.43f, 0.43f, 0.43f, 0.39f); + colors[ImGuiCol_FrameBgHovered] = ImVec4(0.47f, 0.47f, 0.69f, 0.40f); + colors[ImGuiCol_FrameBgActive] = ImVec4(0.42f, 0.41f, 0.64f, 0.69f); + colors[ImGuiCol_TitleBg] = ImVec4(0.27f, 0.27f, 0.54f, 0.83f); + colors[ImGuiCol_TitleBgActive] = ImVec4(0.32f, 0.32f, 0.63f, 0.87f); + colors[ImGuiCol_TitleBgCollapsed] = ImVec4(0.40f, 0.40f, 0.80f, 0.20f); + colors[ImGuiCol_MenuBarBg] = ImVec4(0.40f, 0.40f, 0.55f, 0.80f); + colors[ImGuiCol_ScrollbarBg] = ImVec4(0.20f, 0.25f, 0.30f, 0.60f); + colors[ImGuiCol_ScrollbarGrab] = ImVec4(0.40f, 0.40f, 0.80f, 0.30f); + colors[ImGuiCol_ScrollbarGrabHovered] = ImVec4(0.40f, 0.40f, 0.80f, 0.40f); + colors[ImGuiCol_ScrollbarGrabActive] = ImVec4(0.41f, 0.39f, 0.80f, 0.60f); + colors[ImGuiCol_CheckMark] = ImVec4(0.90f, 0.90f, 0.90f, 0.50f); + colors[ImGuiCol_SliderGrab] = ImVec4(1.00f, 1.00f, 1.00f, 0.30f); + colors[ImGuiCol_SliderGrabActive] = ImVec4(0.41f, 0.39f, 0.80f, 0.60f); + colors[ImGuiCol_Button] = ImVec4(0.35f, 0.40f, 0.61f, 0.62f); + colors[ImGuiCol_ButtonHovered] = ImVec4(0.40f, 0.48f, 0.71f, 0.79f); + colors[ImGuiCol_ButtonActive] = ImVec4(0.46f, 0.54f, 0.80f, 1.00f); + colors[ImGuiCol_Header] = ImVec4(0.40f, 0.40f, 0.90f, 0.45f); + colors[ImGuiCol_HeaderHovered] = ImVec4(0.45f, 0.45f, 0.90f, 0.80f); + colors[ImGuiCol_HeaderActive] = ImVec4(0.53f, 0.53f, 0.87f, 0.80f); + colors[ImGuiCol_Separator] = ImVec4(0.50f, 0.50f, 0.50f, 0.60f); + colors[ImGuiCol_SeparatorHovered] = ImVec4(0.60f, 0.60f, 0.70f, 1.00f); + colors[ImGuiCol_SeparatorActive] = ImVec4(0.70f, 0.70f, 0.90f, 1.00f); + colors[ImGuiCol_ResizeGrip] = ImVec4(1.00f, 1.00f, 1.00f, 0.10f); + colors[ImGuiCol_ResizeGripHovered] = ImVec4(0.78f, 0.82f, 1.00f, 0.60f); + colors[ImGuiCol_ResizeGripActive] = ImVec4(0.78f, 0.82f, 1.00f, 0.90f); + colors[ImGuiCol_Tab] = ImLerp(colors[ImGuiCol_Header], colors[ImGuiCol_TitleBgActive], 0.80f); + colors[ImGuiCol_TabHovered] = colors[ImGuiCol_HeaderHovered]; + colors[ImGuiCol_TabActive] = ImLerp(colors[ImGuiCol_HeaderActive], colors[ImGuiCol_TitleBgActive], 0.60f); + colors[ImGuiCol_TabUnfocused] = ImLerp(colors[ImGuiCol_Tab], colors[ImGuiCol_TitleBg], 0.80f); + colors[ImGuiCol_TabUnfocusedActive] = ImLerp(colors[ImGuiCol_TabActive], colors[ImGuiCol_TitleBg], 0.40f); + colors[ImGuiCol_PlotLines] = ImVec4(1.00f, 1.00f, 1.00f, 1.00f); + colors[ImGuiCol_PlotLinesHovered] = ImVec4(0.90f, 0.70f, 0.00f, 1.00f); + colors[ImGuiCol_PlotHistogram] = ImVec4(0.90f, 0.70f, 0.00f, 1.00f); + colors[ImGuiCol_PlotHistogramHovered] = ImVec4(1.00f, 0.60f, 0.00f, 1.00f); + colors[ImGuiCol_TableHeaderBg] = ImVec4(0.27f, 0.27f, 0.38f, 1.00f); + colors[ImGuiCol_TableBorderStrong] = ImVec4(0.31f, 0.31f, 0.45f, 1.00f); // Prefer using Alpha=1.0 here + colors[ImGuiCol_TableBorderLight] = ImVec4(0.26f, 0.26f, 0.28f, 1.00f); // Prefer using Alpha=1.0 here + colors[ImGuiCol_TableRowBg] = ImVec4(0.00f, 0.00f, 0.00f, 0.00f); + colors[ImGuiCol_TableRowBgAlt] = ImVec4(1.00f, 1.00f, 1.00f, 0.07f); + colors[ImGuiCol_TextSelectedBg] = ImVec4(0.00f, 0.00f, 1.00f, 0.35f); + colors[ImGuiCol_DragDropTarget] = ImVec4(1.00f, 1.00f, 0.00f, 0.90f); + colors[ImGuiCol_NavHighlight] = colors[ImGuiCol_HeaderHovered]; + colors[ImGuiCol_NavWindowingHighlight] = ImVec4(1.00f, 1.00f, 1.00f, 0.70f); + colors[ImGuiCol_NavWindowingDimBg] = ImVec4(0.80f, 0.80f, 0.80f, 0.20f); + colors[ImGuiCol_ModalWindowDimBg] = ImVec4(0.20f, 0.20f, 0.20f, 0.35f); +} + +// Those light colors are better suited with a thicker font than the default one + FrameBorder +void ImGui::StyleColorsLight(ImGuiStyle* dst) +{ + ImGuiStyle* style = dst ? dst : &ImGui::GetStyle(); + ImVec4* colors = style->Colors; + + colors[ImGuiCol_Text] = ImVec4(0.00f, 0.00f, 0.00f, 1.00f); + colors[ImGuiCol_TextDisabled] = ImVec4(0.60f, 0.60f, 0.60f, 1.00f); + colors[ImGuiCol_WindowBg] = ImVec4(0.94f, 0.94f, 0.94f, 1.00f); + colors[ImGuiCol_ChildBg] = ImVec4(0.00f, 0.00f, 0.00f, 0.00f); + colors[ImGuiCol_PopupBg] = ImVec4(1.00f, 1.00f, 1.00f, 0.98f); + colors[ImGuiCol_Border] = ImVec4(0.00f, 0.00f, 0.00f, 0.30f); + colors[ImGuiCol_BorderShadow] = ImVec4(0.00f, 0.00f, 0.00f, 0.00f); + colors[ImGuiCol_FrameBg] = ImVec4(1.00f, 1.00f, 1.00f, 1.00f); + colors[ImGuiCol_FrameBgHovered] = ImVec4(0.26f, 0.59f, 0.98f, 0.40f); + colors[ImGuiCol_FrameBgActive] = ImVec4(0.26f, 0.59f, 0.98f, 0.67f); + colors[ImGuiCol_TitleBg] = ImVec4(0.96f, 0.96f, 0.96f, 1.00f); + colors[ImGuiCol_TitleBgActive] = ImVec4(0.82f, 0.82f, 0.82f, 1.00f); + colors[ImGuiCol_TitleBgCollapsed] = ImVec4(1.00f, 1.00f, 1.00f, 0.51f); + colors[ImGuiCol_MenuBarBg] = ImVec4(0.86f, 0.86f, 0.86f, 1.00f); + colors[ImGuiCol_ScrollbarBg] = ImVec4(0.98f, 0.98f, 0.98f, 0.53f); + colors[ImGuiCol_ScrollbarGrab] = ImVec4(0.69f, 0.69f, 0.69f, 0.80f); + colors[ImGuiCol_ScrollbarGrabHovered] = ImVec4(0.49f, 0.49f, 0.49f, 0.80f); + colors[ImGuiCol_ScrollbarGrabActive] = ImVec4(0.49f, 0.49f, 0.49f, 1.00f); + colors[ImGuiCol_CheckMark] = ImVec4(0.26f, 0.59f, 0.98f, 1.00f); + colors[ImGuiCol_SliderGrab] = ImVec4(0.26f, 0.59f, 0.98f, 0.78f); + colors[ImGuiCol_SliderGrabActive] = ImVec4(0.46f, 0.54f, 0.80f, 0.60f); + colors[ImGuiCol_Button] = ImVec4(0.26f, 0.59f, 0.98f, 0.40f); + colors[ImGuiCol_ButtonHovered] = ImVec4(0.26f, 0.59f, 0.98f, 1.00f); + colors[ImGuiCol_ButtonActive] = ImVec4(0.06f, 0.53f, 0.98f, 1.00f); + colors[ImGuiCol_Header] = ImVec4(0.26f, 0.59f, 0.98f, 0.31f); + colors[ImGuiCol_HeaderHovered] = ImVec4(0.26f, 0.59f, 0.98f, 0.80f); + colors[ImGuiCol_HeaderActive] = ImVec4(0.26f, 0.59f, 0.98f, 1.00f); + colors[ImGuiCol_Separator] = ImVec4(0.39f, 0.39f, 0.39f, 0.62f); + colors[ImGuiCol_SeparatorHovered] = ImVec4(0.14f, 0.44f, 0.80f, 0.78f); + colors[ImGuiCol_SeparatorActive] = ImVec4(0.14f, 0.44f, 0.80f, 1.00f); + colors[ImGuiCol_ResizeGrip] = ImVec4(0.35f, 0.35f, 0.35f, 0.17f); + colors[ImGuiCol_ResizeGripHovered] = ImVec4(0.26f, 0.59f, 0.98f, 0.67f); + colors[ImGuiCol_ResizeGripActive] = ImVec4(0.26f, 0.59f, 0.98f, 0.95f); + colors[ImGuiCol_Tab] = ImLerp(colors[ImGuiCol_Header], colors[ImGuiCol_TitleBgActive], 0.90f); + colors[ImGuiCol_TabHovered] = colors[ImGuiCol_HeaderHovered]; + colors[ImGuiCol_TabActive] = ImLerp(colors[ImGuiCol_HeaderActive], colors[ImGuiCol_TitleBgActive], 0.60f); + colors[ImGuiCol_TabUnfocused] = ImLerp(colors[ImGuiCol_Tab], colors[ImGuiCol_TitleBg], 0.80f); + colors[ImGuiCol_TabUnfocusedActive] = ImLerp(colors[ImGuiCol_TabActive], colors[ImGuiCol_TitleBg], 0.40f); + colors[ImGuiCol_PlotLines] = ImVec4(0.39f, 0.39f, 0.39f, 1.00f); + colors[ImGuiCol_PlotLinesHovered] = ImVec4(1.00f, 0.43f, 0.35f, 1.00f); + colors[ImGuiCol_PlotHistogram] = ImVec4(0.90f, 0.70f, 0.00f, 1.00f); + colors[ImGuiCol_PlotHistogramHovered] = ImVec4(1.00f, 0.45f, 0.00f, 1.00f); + colors[ImGuiCol_TableHeaderBg] = ImVec4(0.78f, 0.87f, 0.98f, 1.00f); + colors[ImGuiCol_TableBorderStrong] = ImVec4(0.57f, 0.57f, 0.64f, 1.00f); // Prefer using Alpha=1.0 here + colors[ImGuiCol_TableBorderLight] = ImVec4(0.68f, 0.68f, 0.74f, 1.00f); // Prefer using Alpha=1.0 here + colors[ImGuiCol_TableRowBg] = ImVec4(0.00f, 0.00f, 0.00f, 0.00f); + colors[ImGuiCol_TableRowBgAlt] = ImVec4(0.30f, 0.30f, 0.30f, 0.09f); + colors[ImGuiCol_TextSelectedBg] = ImVec4(0.26f, 0.59f, 0.98f, 0.35f); + colors[ImGuiCol_DragDropTarget] = ImVec4(0.26f, 0.59f, 0.98f, 0.95f); + colors[ImGuiCol_NavHighlight] = colors[ImGuiCol_HeaderHovered]; + colors[ImGuiCol_NavWindowingHighlight] = ImVec4(0.70f, 0.70f, 0.70f, 0.70f); + colors[ImGuiCol_NavWindowingDimBg] = ImVec4(0.20f, 0.20f, 0.20f, 0.20f); + colors[ImGuiCol_ModalWindowDimBg] = ImVec4(0.20f, 0.20f, 0.20f, 0.35f); +} + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] ImDrawList +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +ImDrawListSharedData::ImDrawListSharedData() +{ + memset(this, 0, sizeof(*this)); + for (int i = 0; i < IM_ARRAYSIZE(ArcFastVtx); i++) + { + const float a = ((float)i * 2 * IM_PI) / (float)IM_ARRAYSIZE(ArcFastVtx); + ArcFastVtx[i] = ImVec2(ImCos(a), ImSin(a)); + } + ArcFastRadiusCutoff = IM_DRAWLIST_CIRCLE_AUTO_SEGMENT_CALC_R(IM_DRAWLIST_ARCFAST_SAMPLE_MAX, CircleSegmentMaxError); +} + +void ImDrawListSharedData::SetCircleTessellationMaxError(float max_error) +{ + if (CircleSegmentMaxError == max_error) + return; + + IM_ASSERT(max_error > 0.0f); + CircleSegmentMaxError = max_error; + for (int i = 0; i < IM_ARRAYSIZE(CircleSegmentCounts); i++) + { + const float radius = (float)i; + CircleSegmentCounts[i] = (ImU8)((i > 0) ? IM_DRAWLIST_CIRCLE_AUTO_SEGMENT_CALC(radius, CircleSegmentMaxError) : 0); + } + ArcFastRadiusCutoff = IM_DRAWLIST_CIRCLE_AUTO_SEGMENT_CALC_R(IM_DRAWLIST_ARCFAST_SAMPLE_MAX, CircleSegmentMaxError); +} + +// Initialize before use in a new frame. We always have a command ready in the buffer. +void ImDrawList::_ResetForNewFrame() +{ + // Verify that the ImDrawCmd fields we want to memcmp() are contiguous in memory. + // (those should be IM_STATIC_ASSERT() in theory but with our pre C++11 setup the whole check doesn't compile with GCC) + IM_ASSERT(IM_OFFSETOF(ImDrawCmd, ClipRect) == 0); + IM_ASSERT(IM_OFFSETOF(ImDrawCmd, TextureId) == sizeof(ImVec4)); + IM_ASSERT(IM_OFFSETOF(ImDrawCmd, VtxOffset) == sizeof(ImVec4) + sizeof(ImTextureID)); + + CmdBuffer.resize(0); + IdxBuffer.resize(0); + VtxBuffer.resize(0); + Flags = _Data->InitialFlags; + memset(&_CmdHeader, 0, sizeof(_CmdHeader)); + _VtxCurrentIdx = 0; + _VtxWritePtr = NULL; + _IdxWritePtr = NULL; + _ClipRectStack.resize(0); + _TextureIdStack.resize(0); + _Path.resize(0); + _Splitter.Clear(); + CmdBuffer.push_back(ImDrawCmd()); + _FringeScale = 1.0f; +} + +void ImDrawList::_ClearFreeMemory() +{ + CmdBuffer.clear(); + IdxBuffer.clear(); + VtxBuffer.clear(); + Flags = ImDrawListFlags_None; + _VtxCurrentIdx = 0; + _VtxWritePtr = NULL; + _IdxWritePtr = NULL; + _ClipRectStack.clear(); + _TextureIdStack.clear(); + _Path.clear(); + _Splitter.ClearFreeMemory(); +} + +ImDrawList* ImDrawList::CloneOutput() const +{ + ImDrawList* dst = IM_NEW(ImDrawList(_Data)); + dst->CmdBuffer = CmdBuffer; + dst->IdxBuffer = IdxBuffer; + dst->VtxBuffer = VtxBuffer; + dst->Flags = Flags; + return dst; +} + +void ImDrawList::AddDrawCmd() +{ + ImDrawCmd draw_cmd; + draw_cmd.ClipRect = _CmdHeader.ClipRect; // Same as calling ImDrawCmd_HeaderCopy() + draw_cmd.TextureId = _CmdHeader.TextureId; + draw_cmd.VtxOffset = _CmdHeader.VtxOffset; + draw_cmd.IdxOffset = IdxBuffer.Size; + + IM_ASSERT(draw_cmd.ClipRect.x <= draw_cmd.ClipRect.z && draw_cmd.ClipRect.y <= draw_cmd.ClipRect.w); + CmdBuffer.push_back(draw_cmd); +} + +// Pop trailing draw command (used before merging or presenting to user) +// Note that this leaves the ImDrawList in a state unfit for further commands, as most code assume that CmdBuffer.Size > 0 && CmdBuffer.back().UserCallback == NULL +void ImDrawList::_PopUnusedDrawCmd() +{ + if (CmdBuffer.Size == 0) + return; + ImDrawCmd* curr_cmd = &CmdBuffer.Data[CmdBuffer.Size - 1]; + if (curr_cmd->ElemCount == 0 && curr_cmd->UserCallback == NULL) + CmdBuffer.pop_back(); +} + +void ImDrawList::AddCallback(ImDrawCallback callback, void* callback_data) +{ + ImDrawCmd* curr_cmd = &CmdBuffer.Data[CmdBuffer.Size - 1]; + IM_ASSERT(curr_cmd->UserCallback == NULL); + if (curr_cmd->ElemCount != 0) + { + AddDrawCmd(); + curr_cmd = &CmdBuffer.Data[CmdBuffer.Size - 1]; + } + curr_cmd->UserCallback = callback; + curr_cmd->UserCallbackData = callback_data; + + AddDrawCmd(); // Force a new command after us (see comment below) +} + +// Compare ClipRect, TextureId and VtxOffset with a single memcmp() +#define ImDrawCmd_HeaderSize (IM_OFFSETOF(ImDrawCmd, VtxOffset) + sizeof(unsigned int)) +#define ImDrawCmd_HeaderCompare(CMD_LHS, CMD_RHS) (memcmp(CMD_LHS, CMD_RHS, ImDrawCmd_HeaderSize)) // Compare ClipRect, TextureId, VtxOffset +#define ImDrawCmd_HeaderCopy(CMD_DST, CMD_SRC) (memcpy(CMD_DST, CMD_SRC, ImDrawCmd_HeaderSize)) // Copy ClipRect, TextureId, VtxOffset + +// Try to merge two last draw commands +void ImDrawList::_TryMergeDrawCmds() +{ + ImDrawCmd* curr_cmd = &CmdBuffer.Data[CmdBuffer.Size - 1]; + ImDrawCmd* prev_cmd = curr_cmd - 1; + if (ImDrawCmd_HeaderCompare(curr_cmd, prev_cmd) == 0 && curr_cmd->UserCallback == NULL && prev_cmd->UserCallback == NULL) + { + prev_cmd->ElemCount += curr_cmd->ElemCount; + CmdBuffer.pop_back(); + } +} + +// Our scheme may appears a bit unusual, basically we want the most-common calls AddLine AddRect etc. to not have to perform any check so we always have a command ready in the stack. +// The cost of figuring out if a new command has to be added or if we can merge is paid in those Update** functions only. +void ImDrawList::_OnChangedClipRect() +{ + // If current command is used with different settings we need to add a new command + ImDrawCmd* curr_cmd = &CmdBuffer.Data[CmdBuffer.Size - 1]; + if (curr_cmd->ElemCount != 0 && memcmp(&curr_cmd->ClipRect, &_CmdHeader.ClipRect, sizeof(ImVec4)) != 0) + { + AddDrawCmd(); + return; + } + IM_ASSERT(curr_cmd->UserCallback == NULL); + + // Try to merge with previous command if it matches, else use current command + ImDrawCmd* prev_cmd = curr_cmd - 1; + if (curr_cmd->ElemCount == 0 && CmdBuffer.Size > 1 && ImDrawCmd_HeaderCompare(&_CmdHeader, prev_cmd) == 0 && prev_cmd->UserCallback == NULL) + { + CmdBuffer.pop_back(); + return; + } + + curr_cmd->ClipRect = _CmdHeader.ClipRect; +} + +void ImDrawList::_OnChangedTextureID() +{ + // If current command is used with different settings we need to add a new command + ImDrawCmd* curr_cmd = &CmdBuffer.Data[CmdBuffer.Size - 1]; + if (curr_cmd->ElemCount != 0 && curr_cmd->TextureId != _CmdHeader.TextureId) + { + AddDrawCmd(); + return; + } + IM_ASSERT(curr_cmd->UserCallback == NULL); + + // Try to merge with previous command if it matches, else use current command + ImDrawCmd* prev_cmd = curr_cmd - 1; + if (curr_cmd->ElemCount == 0 && CmdBuffer.Size > 1 && ImDrawCmd_HeaderCompare(&_CmdHeader, prev_cmd) == 0 && prev_cmd->UserCallback == NULL) + { + CmdBuffer.pop_back(); + return; + } + + curr_cmd->TextureId = _CmdHeader.TextureId; +} + +void ImDrawList::_OnChangedVtxOffset() +{ + // We don't need to compare curr_cmd->VtxOffset != _CmdHeader.VtxOffset because we know it'll be different at the time we call this. + _VtxCurrentIdx = 0; + ImDrawCmd* curr_cmd = &CmdBuffer.Data[CmdBuffer.Size - 1]; + //IM_ASSERT(curr_cmd->VtxOffset != _CmdHeader.VtxOffset); // See #3349 + if (curr_cmd->ElemCount != 0) + { + AddDrawCmd(); + return; + } + IM_ASSERT(curr_cmd->UserCallback == NULL); + curr_cmd->VtxOffset = _CmdHeader.VtxOffset; +} + +int ImDrawList::_CalcCircleAutoSegmentCount(float radius) const +{ + // Automatic segment count + const int radius_idx = (int)(radius + 0.999999f); // ceil to never reduce accuracy + if (radius_idx < IM_ARRAYSIZE(_Data->CircleSegmentCounts)) + return _Data->CircleSegmentCounts[radius_idx]; // Use cached value + else + return IM_DRAWLIST_CIRCLE_AUTO_SEGMENT_CALC(radius, _Data->CircleSegmentMaxError); +} + +// Render-level scissoring. This is passed down to your render function but not used for CPU-side coarse clipping. Prefer using higher-level ImGui::PushClipRect() to affect logic (hit-testing and widget culling) +void ImDrawList::PushClipRect(ImVec2 cr_min, ImVec2 cr_max, bool intersect_with_current_clip_rect) +{ + ImVec4 cr(cr_min.x, cr_min.y, cr_max.x, cr_max.y); + if (intersect_with_current_clip_rect) + { + ImVec4 current = _CmdHeader.ClipRect; + if (cr.x < current.x) cr.x = current.x; + if (cr.y < current.y) cr.y = current.y; + if (cr.z > current.z) cr.z = current.z; + if (cr.w > current.w) cr.w = current.w; + } + cr.z = ImMax(cr.x, cr.z); + cr.w = ImMax(cr.y, cr.w); + + _ClipRectStack.push_back(cr); + _CmdHeader.ClipRect = cr; + _OnChangedClipRect(); +} + +void ImDrawList::PushClipRectFullScreen() +{ + PushClipRect(ImVec2(_Data->ClipRectFullscreen.x, _Data->ClipRectFullscreen.y), ImVec2(_Data->ClipRectFullscreen.z, _Data->ClipRectFullscreen.w)); +} + +void ImDrawList::PopClipRect() +{ + _ClipRectStack.pop_back(); + _CmdHeader.ClipRect = (_ClipRectStack.Size == 0) ? _Data->ClipRectFullscreen : _ClipRectStack.Data[_ClipRectStack.Size - 1]; + _OnChangedClipRect(); +} + +void ImDrawList::PushTextureID(ImTextureID texture_id) +{ + _TextureIdStack.push_back(texture_id); + _CmdHeader.TextureId = texture_id; + _OnChangedTextureID(); +} + +void ImDrawList::PopTextureID() +{ + _TextureIdStack.pop_back(); + _CmdHeader.TextureId = (_TextureIdStack.Size == 0) ? (ImTextureID)NULL : _TextureIdStack.Data[_TextureIdStack.Size - 1]; + _OnChangedTextureID(); +} + +// Reserve space for a number of vertices and indices. +// You must finish filling your reserved data before calling PrimReserve() again, as it may reallocate or +// submit the intermediate results. PrimUnreserve() can be used to release unused allocations. +void ImDrawList::PrimReserve(int idx_count, int vtx_count) +{ + // Large mesh support (when enabled) + IM_ASSERT_PARANOID(idx_count >= 0 && vtx_count >= 0); + if (sizeof(ImDrawIdx) == 2 && (_VtxCurrentIdx + vtx_count >= (1 << 16)) && (Flags & ImDrawListFlags_AllowVtxOffset)) + { + // FIXME: In theory we should be testing that vtx_count <64k here. + // In practice, RenderText() relies on reserving ahead for a worst case scenario so it is currently useful for us + // to not make that check until we rework the text functions to handle clipping and large horizontal lines better. + _CmdHeader.VtxOffset = VtxBuffer.Size; + _OnChangedVtxOffset(); + } + + ImDrawCmd* draw_cmd = &CmdBuffer.Data[CmdBuffer.Size - 1]; + draw_cmd->ElemCount += idx_count; + + int vtx_buffer_old_size = VtxBuffer.Size; + VtxBuffer.resize(vtx_buffer_old_size + vtx_count); + _VtxWritePtr = VtxBuffer.Data + vtx_buffer_old_size; + + int idx_buffer_old_size = IdxBuffer.Size; + IdxBuffer.resize(idx_buffer_old_size + idx_count); + _IdxWritePtr = IdxBuffer.Data + idx_buffer_old_size; +} + +// Release the a number of reserved vertices/indices from the end of the last reservation made with PrimReserve(). +void ImDrawList::PrimUnreserve(int idx_count, int vtx_count) +{ + IM_ASSERT_PARANOID(idx_count >= 0 && vtx_count >= 0); + + ImDrawCmd* draw_cmd = &CmdBuffer.Data[CmdBuffer.Size - 1]; + draw_cmd->ElemCount -= idx_count; + VtxBuffer.shrink(VtxBuffer.Size - vtx_count); + IdxBuffer.shrink(IdxBuffer.Size - idx_count); +} + +// Fully unrolled with inline call to keep our debug builds decently fast. +void ImDrawList::PrimRect(const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& c, ImU32 col) +{ + ImVec2 b(c.x, a.y), d(a.x, c.y), uv(_Data->TexUvWhitePixel); + ImDrawIdx idx = (ImDrawIdx)_VtxCurrentIdx; + _IdxWritePtr[0] = idx; _IdxWritePtr[1] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx+1); _IdxWritePtr[2] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx+2); + _IdxWritePtr[3] = idx; _IdxWritePtr[4] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx+2); _IdxWritePtr[5] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx+3); + _VtxWritePtr[0].pos = a; _VtxWritePtr[0].uv = uv; _VtxWritePtr[0].col = col; + _VtxWritePtr[1].pos = b; _VtxWritePtr[1].uv = uv; _VtxWritePtr[1].col = col; + _VtxWritePtr[2].pos = c; _VtxWritePtr[2].uv = uv; _VtxWritePtr[2].col = col; + _VtxWritePtr[3].pos = d; _VtxWritePtr[3].uv = uv; _VtxWritePtr[3].col = col; + _VtxWritePtr += 4; + _VtxCurrentIdx += 4; + _IdxWritePtr += 6; +} + +void ImDrawList::PrimRectUV(const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& c, const ImVec2& uv_a, const ImVec2& uv_c, ImU32 col) +{ + ImVec2 b(c.x, a.y), d(a.x, c.y), uv_b(uv_c.x, uv_a.y), uv_d(uv_a.x, uv_c.y); + ImDrawIdx idx = (ImDrawIdx)_VtxCurrentIdx; + _IdxWritePtr[0] = idx; _IdxWritePtr[1] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx+1); _IdxWritePtr[2] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx+2); + _IdxWritePtr[3] = idx; _IdxWritePtr[4] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx+2); _IdxWritePtr[5] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx+3); + _VtxWritePtr[0].pos = a; _VtxWritePtr[0].uv = uv_a; _VtxWritePtr[0].col = col; + _VtxWritePtr[1].pos = b; _VtxWritePtr[1].uv = uv_b; _VtxWritePtr[1].col = col; + _VtxWritePtr[2].pos = c; _VtxWritePtr[2].uv = uv_c; _VtxWritePtr[2].col = col; + _VtxWritePtr[3].pos = d; _VtxWritePtr[3].uv = uv_d; _VtxWritePtr[3].col = col; + _VtxWritePtr += 4; + _VtxCurrentIdx += 4; + _IdxWritePtr += 6; +} + +void ImDrawList::PrimQuadUV(const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& b, const ImVec2& c, const ImVec2& d, const ImVec2& uv_a, const ImVec2& uv_b, const ImVec2& uv_c, const ImVec2& uv_d, ImU32 col) +{ + ImDrawIdx idx = (ImDrawIdx)_VtxCurrentIdx; + _IdxWritePtr[0] = idx; _IdxWritePtr[1] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx+1); _IdxWritePtr[2] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx+2); + _IdxWritePtr[3] = idx; _IdxWritePtr[4] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx+2); _IdxWritePtr[5] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx+3); + _VtxWritePtr[0].pos = a; _VtxWritePtr[0].uv = uv_a; _VtxWritePtr[0].col = col; + _VtxWritePtr[1].pos = b; _VtxWritePtr[1].uv = uv_b; _VtxWritePtr[1].col = col; + _VtxWritePtr[2].pos = c; _VtxWritePtr[2].uv = uv_c; _VtxWritePtr[2].col = col; + _VtxWritePtr[3].pos = d; _VtxWritePtr[3].uv = uv_d; _VtxWritePtr[3].col = col; + _VtxWritePtr += 4; + _VtxCurrentIdx += 4; + _IdxWritePtr += 6; +} + +// On AddPolyline() and AddConvexPolyFilled() we intentionally avoid using ImVec2 and superfluous function calls to optimize debug/non-inlined builds. +// - Those macros expects l-values and need to be used as their own statement. +// - Those macros are intentionally not surrounded by the 'do {} while (0)' idiom because even that translates to runtime with debug compilers. +#define IM_NORMALIZE2F_OVER_ZERO(VX,VY) { float d2 = VX*VX + VY*VY; if (d2 > 0.0f) { float inv_len = ImRsqrt(d2); VX *= inv_len; VY *= inv_len; } } (void)0 +#define IM_FIXNORMAL2F_MAX_INVLEN2 100.0f // 500.0f (see #4053, #3366) +#define IM_FIXNORMAL2F(VX,VY) { float d2 = VX*VX + VY*VY; if (d2 > 0.000001f) { float inv_len2 = 1.0f / d2; if (inv_len2 > IM_FIXNORMAL2F_MAX_INVLEN2) inv_len2 = IM_FIXNORMAL2F_MAX_INVLEN2; VX *= inv_len2; VY *= inv_len2; } } (void)0 + +// TODO: Thickness anti-aliased lines cap are missing their AA fringe. +// We avoid using the ImVec2 math operators here to reduce cost to a minimum for debug/non-inlined builds. +void ImDrawList::AddPolyline(const ImVec2* points, const int points_count, ImU32 col, ImDrawFlags flags, float thickness) +{ + if (points_count < 2) + return; + + const bool closed = (flags & ImDrawFlags_Closed) != 0; + const ImVec2 opaque_uv = _Data->TexUvWhitePixel; + const int count = closed ? points_count : points_count - 1; // The number of line segments we need to draw + const bool thick_line = (thickness > _FringeScale); + + if (Flags & ImDrawListFlags_AntiAliasedLines) + { + // Anti-aliased stroke + const float AA_SIZE = _FringeScale; + const ImU32 col_trans = col & ~IM_COL32_A_MASK; + + // Thicknesses <1.0 should behave like thickness 1.0 + thickness = ImMax(thickness, 1.0f); + const int integer_thickness = (int)thickness; + const float fractional_thickness = thickness - integer_thickness; + + // Do we want to draw this line using a texture? + // - For now, only draw integer-width lines using textures to avoid issues with the way scaling occurs, could be improved. + // - If AA_SIZE is not 1.0f we cannot use the texture path. + const bool use_texture = (Flags & ImDrawListFlags_AntiAliasedLinesUseTex) && (integer_thickness < IM_DRAWLIST_TEX_LINES_WIDTH_MAX) && (fractional_thickness <= 0.00001f) && (AA_SIZE == 1.0f); + + // We should never hit this, because NewFrame() doesn't set ImDrawListFlags_AntiAliasedLinesUseTex unless ImFontAtlasFlags_NoBakedLines is off + IM_ASSERT_PARANOID(!use_texture || !(_Data->Font->ContainerAtlas->Flags & ImFontAtlasFlags_NoBakedLines)); + + const int idx_count = use_texture ? (count * 6) : (thick_line ? count * 18 : count * 12); + const int vtx_count = use_texture ? (points_count * 2) : (thick_line ? points_count * 4 : points_count * 3); + PrimReserve(idx_count, vtx_count); + + // Temporary buffer + // The first items are normals at each line point, then after that there are either 2 or 4 temp points for each line point + ImVec2* temp_normals = (ImVec2*)alloca(points_count * ((use_texture || !thick_line) ? 3 : 5) * sizeof(ImVec2)); //-V630 + ImVec2* temp_points = temp_normals + points_count; + + // Calculate normals (tangents) for each line segment + for (int i1 = 0; i1 < count; i1++) + { + const int i2 = (i1 + 1) == points_count ? 0 : i1 + 1; + float dx = points[i2].x - points[i1].x; + float dy = points[i2].y - points[i1].y; + IM_NORMALIZE2F_OVER_ZERO(dx, dy); + temp_normals[i1].x = dy; + temp_normals[i1].y = -dx; + } + if (!closed) + temp_normals[points_count - 1] = temp_normals[points_count - 2]; + + // If we are drawing a one-pixel-wide line without a texture, or a textured line of any width, we only need 2 or 3 vertices per point + if (use_texture || !thick_line) + { + // [PATH 1] Texture-based lines (thick or non-thick) + // [PATH 2] Non texture-based lines (non-thick) + + // The width of the geometry we need to draw - this is essentially pixels for the line itself, plus "one pixel" for AA. + // - In the texture-based path, we don't use AA_SIZE here because the +1 is tied to the generated texture + // (see ImFontAtlasBuildRenderLinesTexData() function), and so alternate values won't work without changes to that code. + // - In the non texture-based paths, we would allow AA_SIZE to potentially be != 1.0f with a patch (e.g. fringe_scale patch to + // allow scaling geometry while preserving one-screen-pixel AA fringe). + const float half_draw_size = use_texture ? ((thickness * 0.5f) + 1) : AA_SIZE; + + // If line is not closed, the first and last points need to be generated differently as there are no normals to blend + if (!closed) + { + temp_points[0] = points[0] + temp_normals[0] * half_draw_size; + temp_points[1] = points[0] - temp_normals[0] * half_draw_size; + temp_points[(points_count-1)*2+0] = points[points_count-1] + temp_normals[points_count-1] * half_draw_size; + temp_points[(points_count-1)*2+1] = points[points_count-1] - temp_normals[points_count-1] * half_draw_size; + } + + // Generate the indices to form a number of triangles for each line segment, and the vertices for the line edges + // This takes points n and n+1 and writes into n+1, with the first point in a closed line being generated from the final one (as n+1 wraps) + // FIXME-OPT: Merge the different loops, possibly remove the temporary buffer. + unsigned int idx1 = _VtxCurrentIdx; // Vertex index for start of line segment + for (int i1 = 0; i1 < count; i1++) // i1 is the first point of the line segment + { + const int i2 = (i1 + 1) == points_count ? 0 : i1 + 1; // i2 is the second point of the line segment + const unsigned int idx2 = ((i1 + 1) == points_count) ? _VtxCurrentIdx : (idx1 + (use_texture ? 2 : 3)); // Vertex index for end of segment + + // Average normals + float dm_x = (temp_normals[i1].x + temp_normals[i2].x) * 0.5f; + float dm_y = (temp_normals[i1].y + temp_normals[i2].y) * 0.5f; + IM_FIXNORMAL2F(dm_x, dm_y); + dm_x *= half_draw_size; // dm_x, dm_y are offset to the outer edge of the AA area + dm_y *= half_draw_size; + + // Add temporary vertexes for the outer edges + ImVec2* out_vtx = &temp_points[i2 * 2]; + out_vtx[0].x = points[i2].x + dm_x; + out_vtx[0].y = points[i2].y + dm_y; + out_vtx[1].x = points[i2].x - dm_x; + out_vtx[1].y = points[i2].y - dm_y; + + if (use_texture) + { + // Add indices for two triangles + _IdxWritePtr[0] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx2 + 0); _IdxWritePtr[1] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx1 + 0); _IdxWritePtr[2] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx1 + 1); // Right tri + _IdxWritePtr[3] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx2 + 1); _IdxWritePtr[4] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx1 + 1); _IdxWritePtr[5] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx2 + 0); // Left tri + _IdxWritePtr += 6; + } + else + { + // Add indexes for four triangles + _IdxWritePtr[0] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx2 + 0); _IdxWritePtr[1] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx1 + 0); _IdxWritePtr[2] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx1 + 2); // Right tri 1 + _IdxWritePtr[3] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx1 + 2); _IdxWritePtr[4] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx2 + 2); _IdxWritePtr[5] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx2 + 0); // Right tri 2 + _IdxWritePtr[6] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx2 + 1); _IdxWritePtr[7] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx1 + 1); _IdxWritePtr[8] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx1 + 0); // Left tri 1 + _IdxWritePtr[9] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx1 + 0); _IdxWritePtr[10] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx2 + 0); _IdxWritePtr[11] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx2 + 1); // Left tri 2 + _IdxWritePtr += 12; + } + + idx1 = idx2; + } + + // Add vertexes for each point on the line + if (use_texture) + { + // If we're using textures we only need to emit the left/right edge vertices + ImVec4 tex_uvs = _Data->TexUvLines[integer_thickness]; + /*if (fractional_thickness != 0.0f) // Currently always zero when use_texture==false! + { + const ImVec4 tex_uvs_1 = _Data->TexUvLines[integer_thickness + 1]; + tex_uvs.x = tex_uvs.x + (tex_uvs_1.x - tex_uvs.x) * fractional_thickness; // inlined ImLerp() + tex_uvs.y = tex_uvs.y + (tex_uvs_1.y - tex_uvs.y) * fractional_thickness; + tex_uvs.z = tex_uvs.z + (tex_uvs_1.z - tex_uvs.z) * fractional_thickness; + tex_uvs.w = tex_uvs.w + (tex_uvs_1.w - tex_uvs.w) * fractional_thickness; + }*/ + ImVec2 tex_uv0(tex_uvs.x, tex_uvs.y); + ImVec2 tex_uv1(tex_uvs.z, tex_uvs.w); + for (int i = 0; i < points_count; i++) + { + _VtxWritePtr[0].pos = temp_points[i * 2 + 0]; _VtxWritePtr[0].uv = tex_uv0; _VtxWritePtr[0].col = col; // Left-side outer edge + _VtxWritePtr[1].pos = temp_points[i * 2 + 1]; _VtxWritePtr[1].uv = tex_uv1; _VtxWritePtr[1].col = col; // Right-side outer edge + _VtxWritePtr += 2; + } + } + else + { + // If we're not using a texture, we need the center vertex as well + for (int i = 0; i < points_count; i++) + { + _VtxWritePtr[0].pos = points[i]; _VtxWritePtr[0].uv = opaque_uv; _VtxWritePtr[0].col = col; // Center of line + _VtxWritePtr[1].pos = temp_points[i * 2 + 0]; _VtxWritePtr[1].uv = opaque_uv; _VtxWritePtr[1].col = col_trans; // Left-side outer edge + _VtxWritePtr[2].pos = temp_points[i * 2 + 1]; _VtxWritePtr[2].uv = opaque_uv; _VtxWritePtr[2].col = col_trans; // Right-side outer edge + _VtxWritePtr += 3; + } + } + } + else + { + // [PATH 2] Non texture-based lines (thick): we need to draw the solid line core and thus require four vertices per point + const float half_inner_thickness = (thickness - AA_SIZE) * 0.5f; + + // If line is not closed, the first and last points need to be generated differently as there are no normals to blend + if (!closed) + { + const int points_last = points_count - 1; + temp_points[0] = points[0] + temp_normals[0] * (half_inner_thickness + AA_SIZE); + temp_points[1] = points[0] + temp_normals[0] * (half_inner_thickness); + temp_points[2] = points[0] - temp_normals[0] * (half_inner_thickness); + temp_points[3] = points[0] - temp_normals[0] * (half_inner_thickness + AA_SIZE); + temp_points[points_last * 4 + 0] = points[points_last] + temp_normals[points_last] * (half_inner_thickness + AA_SIZE); + temp_points[points_last * 4 + 1] = points[points_last] + temp_normals[points_last] * (half_inner_thickness); + temp_points[points_last * 4 + 2] = points[points_last] - temp_normals[points_last] * (half_inner_thickness); + temp_points[points_last * 4 + 3] = points[points_last] - temp_normals[points_last] * (half_inner_thickness + AA_SIZE); + } + + // Generate the indices to form a number of triangles for each line segment, and the vertices for the line edges + // This takes points n and n+1 and writes into n+1, with the first point in a closed line being generated from the final one (as n+1 wraps) + // FIXME-OPT: Merge the different loops, possibly remove the temporary buffer. + unsigned int idx1 = _VtxCurrentIdx; // Vertex index for start of line segment + for (int i1 = 0; i1 < count; i1++) // i1 is the first point of the line segment + { + const int i2 = (i1 + 1) == points_count ? 0 : (i1 + 1); // i2 is the second point of the line segment + const unsigned int idx2 = (i1 + 1) == points_count ? _VtxCurrentIdx : (idx1 + 4); // Vertex index for end of segment + + // Average normals + float dm_x = (temp_normals[i1].x + temp_normals[i2].x) * 0.5f; + float dm_y = (temp_normals[i1].y + temp_normals[i2].y) * 0.5f; + IM_FIXNORMAL2F(dm_x, dm_y); + float dm_out_x = dm_x * (half_inner_thickness + AA_SIZE); + float dm_out_y = dm_y * (half_inner_thickness + AA_SIZE); + float dm_in_x = dm_x * half_inner_thickness; + float dm_in_y = dm_y * half_inner_thickness; + + // Add temporary vertices + ImVec2* out_vtx = &temp_points[i2 * 4]; + out_vtx[0].x = points[i2].x + dm_out_x; + out_vtx[0].y = points[i2].y + dm_out_y; + out_vtx[1].x = points[i2].x + dm_in_x; + out_vtx[1].y = points[i2].y + dm_in_y; + out_vtx[2].x = points[i2].x - dm_in_x; + out_vtx[2].y = points[i2].y - dm_in_y; + out_vtx[3].x = points[i2].x - dm_out_x; + out_vtx[3].y = points[i2].y - dm_out_y; + + // Add indexes + _IdxWritePtr[0] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx2 + 1); _IdxWritePtr[1] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx1 + 1); _IdxWritePtr[2] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx1 + 2); + _IdxWritePtr[3] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx1 + 2); _IdxWritePtr[4] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx2 + 2); _IdxWritePtr[5] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx2 + 1); + _IdxWritePtr[6] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx2 + 1); _IdxWritePtr[7] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx1 + 1); _IdxWritePtr[8] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx1 + 0); + _IdxWritePtr[9] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx1 + 0); _IdxWritePtr[10] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx2 + 0); _IdxWritePtr[11] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx2 + 1); + _IdxWritePtr[12] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx2 + 2); _IdxWritePtr[13] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx1 + 2); _IdxWritePtr[14] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx1 + 3); + _IdxWritePtr[15] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx1 + 3); _IdxWritePtr[16] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx2 + 3); _IdxWritePtr[17] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx2 + 2); + _IdxWritePtr += 18; + + idx1 = idx2; + } + + // Add vertices + for (int i = 0; i < points_count; i++) + { + _VtxWritePtr[0].pos = temp_points[i * 4 + 0]; _VtxWritePtr[0].uv = opaque_uv; _VtxWritePtr[0].col = col_trans; + _VtxWritePtr[1].pos = temp_points[i * 4 + 1]; _VtxWritePtr[1].uv = opaque_uv; _VtxWritePtr[1].col = col; + _VtxWritePtr[2].pos = temp_points[i * 4 + 2]; _VtxWritePtr[2].uv = opaque_uv; _VtxWritePtr[2].col = col; + _VtxWritePtr[3].pos = temp_points[i * 4 + 3]; _VtxWritePtr[3].uv = opaque_uv; _VtxWritePtr[3].col = col_trans; + _VtxWritePtr += 4; + } + } + _VtxCurrentIdx += (ImDrawIdx)vtx_count; + } + else + { + // [PATH 4] Non texture-based, Non anti-aliased lines + const int idx_count = count * 6; + const int vtx_count = count * 4; // FIXME-OPT: Not sharing edges + PrimReserve(idx_count, vtx_count); + + for (int i1 = 0; i1 < count; i1++) + { + const int i2 = (i1 + 1) == points_count ? 0 : i1 + 1; + const ImVec2& p1 = points[i1]; + const ImVec2& p2 = points[i2]; + + float dx = p2.x - p1.x; + float dy = p2.y - p1.y; + IM_NORMALIZE2F_OVER_ZERO(dx, dy); + dx *= (thickness * 0.5f); + dy *= (thickness * 0.5f); + + _VtxWritePtr[0].pos.x = p1.x + dy; _VtxWritePtr[0].pos.y = p1.y - dx; _VtxWritePtr[0].uv = opaque_uv; _VtxWritePtr[0].col = col; + _VtxWritePtr[1].pos.x = p2.x + dy; _VtxWritePtr[1].pos.y = p2.y - dx; _VtxWritePtr[1].uv = opaque_uv; _VtxWritePtr[1].col = col; + _VtxWritePtr[2].pos.x = p2.x - dy; _VtxWritePtr[2].pos.y = p2.y + dx; _VtxWritePtr[2].uv = opaque_uv; _VtxWritePtr[2].col = col; + _VtxWritePtr[3].pos.x = p1.x - dy; _VtxWritePtr[3].pos.y = p1.y + dx; _VtxWritePtr[3].uv = opaque_uv; _VtxWritePtr[3].col = col; + _VtxWritePtr += 4; + + _IdxWritePtr[0] = (ImDrawIdx)(_VtxCurrentIdx); _IdxWritePtr[1] = (ImDrawIdx)(_VtxCurrentIdx + 1); _IdxWritePtr[2] = (ImDrawIdx)(_VtxCurrentIdx + 2); + _IdxWritePtr[3] = (ImDrawIdx)(_VtxCurrentIdx); _IdxWritePtr[4] = (ImDrawIdx)(_VtxCurrentIdx + 2); _IdxWritePtr[5] = (ImDrawIdx)(_VtxCurrentIdx + 3); + _IdxWritePtr += 6; + _VtxCurrentIdx += 4; + } + } +} + +// We intentionally avoid using ImVec2 and its math operators here to reduce cost to a minimum for debug/non-inlined builds. +void ImDrawList::AddConvexPolyFilled(const ImVec2* points, const int points_count, ImU32 col) +{ + if (points_count < 3) + return; + + const ImVec2 uv = _Data->TexUvWhitePixel; + + if (Flags & ImDrawListFlags_AntiAliasedFill) + { + // Anti-aliased Fill + const float AA_SIZE = _FringeScale; + const ImU32 col_trans = col & ~IM_COL32_A_MASK; + const int idx_count = (points_count - 2)*3 + points_count * 6; + const int vtx_count = (points_count * 2); + PrimReserve(idx_count, vtx_count); + + // Add indexes for fill + unsigned int vtx_inner_idx = _VtxCurrentIdx; + unsigned int vtx_outer_idx = _VtxCurrentIdx + 1; + for (int i = 2; i < points_count; i++) + { + _IdxWritePtr[0] = (ImDrawIdx)(vtx_inner_idx); _IdxWritePtr[1] = (ImDrawIdx)(vtx_inner_idx + ((i - 1) << 1)); _IdxWritePtr[2] = (ImDrawIdx)(vtx_inner_idx + (i << 1)); + _IdxWritePtr += 3; + } + + // Compute normals + ImVec2* temp_normals = (ImVec2*)alloca(points_count * sizeof(ImVec2)); //-V630 + for (int i0 = points_count - 1, i1 = 0; i1 < points_count; i0 = i1++) + { + const ImVec2& p0 = points[i0]; + const ImVec2& p1 = points[i1]; + float dx = p1.x - p0.x; + float dy = p1.y - p0.y; + IM_NORMALIZE2F_OVER_ZERO(dx, dy); + temp_normals[i0].x = dy; + temp_normals[i0].y = -dx; + } + + for (int i0 = points_count - 1, i1 = 0; i1 < points_count; i0 = i1++) + { + // Average normals + const ImVec2& n0 = temp_normals[i0]; + const ImVec2& n1 = temp_normals[i1]; + float dm_x = (n0.x + n1.x) * 0.5f; + float dm_y = (n0.y + n1.y) * 0.5f; + IM_FIXNORMAL2F(dm_x, dm_y); + dm_x *= AA_SIZE * 0.5f; + dm_y *= AA_SIZE * 0.5f; + + // Add vertices + _VtxWritePtr[0].pos.x = (points[i1].x - dm_x); _VtxWritePtr[0].pos.y = (points[i1].y - dm_y); _VtxWritePtr[0].uv = uv; _VtxWritePtr[0].col = col; // Inner + _VtxWritePtr[1].pos.x = (points[i1].x + dm_x); _VtxWritePtr[1].pos.y = (points[i1].y + dm_y); _VtxWritePtr[1].uv = uv; _VtxWritePtr[1].col = col_trans; // Outer + _VtxWritePtr += 2; + + // Add indexes for fringes + _IdxWritePtr[0] = (ImDrawIdx)(vtx_inner_idx + (i1 << 1)); _IdxWritePtr[1] = (ImDrawIdx)(vtx_inner_idx + (i0 << 1)); _IdxWritePtr[2] = (ImDrawIdx)(vtx_outer_idx + (i0 << 1)); + _IdxWritePtr[3] = (ImDrawIdx)(vtx_outer_idx + (i0 << 1)); _IdxWritePtr[4] = (ImDrawIdx)(vtx_outer_idx + (i1 << 1)); _IdxWritePtr[5] = (ImDrawIdx)(vtx_inner_idx + (i1 << 1)); + _IdxWritePtr += 6; + } + _VtxCurrentIdx += (ImDrawIdx)vtx_count; + } + else + { + // Non Anti-aliased Fill + const int idx_count = (points_count - 2)*3; + const int vtx_count = points_count; + PrimReserve(idx_count, vtx_count); + for (int i = 0; i < vtx_count; i++) + { + _VtxWritePtr[0].pos = points[i]; _VtxWritePtr[0].uv = uv; _VtxWritePtr[0].col = col; + _VtxWritePtr++; + } + for (int i = 2; i < points_count; i++) + { + _IdxWritePtr[0] = (ImDrawIdx)(_VtxCurrentIdx); _IdxWritePtr[1] = (ImDrawIdx)(_VtxCurrentIdx + i - 1); _IdxWritePtr[2] = (ImDrawIdx)(_VtxCurrentIdx + i); + _IdxWritePtr += 3; + } + _VtxCurrentIdx += (ImDrawIdx)vtx_count; + } +} + +void ImDrawList::_PathArcToFastEx(const ImVec2& center, float radius, int a_min_sample, int a_max_sample, int a_step) +{ + if (radius <= 0.0f) + { + _Path.push_back(center); + return; + } + + // Calculate arc auto segment step size + if (a_step <= 0) + a_step = IM_DRAWLIST_ARCFAST_SAMPLE_MAX / _CalcCircleAutoSegmentCount(radius); + + // Make sure we never do steps larger than one quarter of the circle + a_step = ImClamp(a_step, 1, IM_DRAWLIST_ARCFAST_TABLE_SIZE / 4); + + const int sample_range = ImAbs(a_max_sample - a_min_sample); + const int a_next_step = a_step; + + int samples = sample_range + 1; + bool extra_max_sample = false; + if (a_step > 1) + { + samples = sample_range / a_step + 1; + const int overstep = sample_range % a_step; + + if (overstep > 0) + { + extra_max_sample = true; + samples++; + + // When we have overstep to avoid awkwardly looking one long line and one tiny one at the end, + // distribute first step range evenly between them by reducing first step size. + if (sample_range > 0) + a_step -= (a_step - overstep) / 2; + } + } + + _Path.resize(_Path.Size + samples); + ImVec2* out_ptr = _Path.Data + (_Path.Size - samples); + + int sample_index = a_min_sample; + if (sample_index < 0 || sample_index >= IM_DRAWLIST_ARCFAST_SAMPLE_MAX) + { + sample_index = sample_index % IM_DRAWLIST_ARCFAST_SAMPLE_MAX; + if (sample_index < 0) + sample_index += IM_DRAWLIST_ARCFAST_SAMPLE_MAX; + } + + if (a_max_sample >= a_min_sample) + { + for (int a = a_min_sample; a <= a_max_sample; a += a_step, sample_index += a_step, a_step = a_next_step) + { + // a_step is clamped to IM_DRAWLIST_ARCFAST_SAMPLE_MAX, so we have guaranteed that it will not wrap over range twice or more + if (sample_index >= IM_DRAWLIST_ARCFAST_SAMPLE_MAX) + sample_index -= IM_DRAWLIST_ARCFAST_SAMPLE_MAX; + + const ImVec2 s = _Data->ArcFastVtx[sample_index]; + out_ptr->x = center.x + s.x * radius; + out_ptr->y = center.y + s.y * radius; + out_ptr++; + } + } + else + { + for (int a = a_min_sample; a >= a_max_sample; a -= a_step, sample_index -= a_step, a_step = a_next_step) + { + // a_step is clamped to IM_DRAWLIST_ARCFAST_SAMPLE_MAX, so we have guaranteed that it will not wrap over range twice or more + if (sample_index < 0) + sample_index += IM_DRAWLIST_ARCFAST_SAMPLE_MAX; + + const ImVec2 s = _Data->ArcFastVtx[sample_index]; + out_ptr->x = center.x + s.x * radius; + out_ptr->y = center.y + s.y * radius; + out_ptr++; + } + } + + if (extra_max_sample) + { + int normalized_max_sample = a_max_sample % IM_DRAWLIST_ARCFAST_SAMPLE_MAX; + if (normalized_max_sample < 0) + normalized_max_sample += IM_DRAWLIST_ARCFAST_SAMPLE_MAX; + + const ImVec2 s = _Data->ArcFastVtx[normalized_max_sample]; + out_ptr->x = center.x + s.x * radius; + out_ptr->y = center.y + s.y * radius; + out_ptr++; + } + + IM_ASSERT_PARANOID(_Path.Data + _Path.Size == out_ptr); +} + +void ImDrawList::_PathArcToN(const ImVec2& center, float radius, float a_min, float a_max, int num_segments) +{ + if (radius <= 0.0f) + { + _Path.push_back(center); + return; + } + + // Note that we are adding a point at both a_min and a_max. + // If you are trying to draw a full closed circle you don't want the overlapping points! + _Path.reserve(_Path.Size + (num_segments + 1)); + for (int i = 0; i <= num_segments; i++) + { + const float a = a_min + ((float)i / (float)num_segments) * (a_max - a_min); + _Path.push_back(ImVec2(center.x + ImCos(a) * radius, center.y + ImSin(a) * radius)); + } +} + +// 0: East, 3: South, 6: West, 9: North, 12: East +void ImDrawList::PathArcToFast(const ImVec2& center, float radius, int a_min_of_12, int a_max_of_12) +{ + if (radius <= 0.0f) + { + _Path.push_back(center); + return; + } + _PathArcToFastEx(center, radius, a_min_of_12 * IM_DRAWLIST_ARCFAST_SAMPLE_MAX / 12, a_max_of_12 * IM_DRAWLIST_ARCFAST_SAMPLE_MAX / 12, 0); +} + +void ImDrawList::PathArcTo(const ImVec2& center, float radius, float a_min, float a_max, int num_segments) +{ + if (radius <= 0.0f) + { + _Path.push_back(center); + return; + } + + if (num_segments > 0) + { + _PathArcToN(center, radius, a_min, a_max, num_segments); + return; + } + + // Automatic segment count + if (radius <= _Data->ArcFastRadiusCutoff) + { + const bool a_is_reverse = a_max < a_min; + + // We are going to use precomputed values for mid samples. + // Determine first and last sample in lookup table that belong to the arc. + const float a_min_sample_f = IM_DRAWLIST_ARCFAST_SAMPLE_MAX * a_min / (IM_PI * 2.0f); + const float a_max_sample_f = IM_DRAWLIST_ARCFAST_SAMPLE_MAX * a_max / (IM_PI * 2.0f); + + const int a_min_sample = a_is_reverse ? (int)ImFloorSigned(a_min_sample_f) : (int)ImCeil(a_min_sample_f); + const int a_max_sample = a_is_reverse ? (int)ImCeil(a_max_sample_f) : (int)ImFloorSigned(a_max_sample_f); + const int a_mid_samples = a_is_reverse ? ImMax(a_min_sample - a_max_sample, 0) : ImMax(a_max_sample - a_min_sample, 0); + + const float a_min_segment_angle = a_min_sample * IM_PI * 2.0f / IM_DRAWLIST_ARCFAST_SAMPLE_MAX; + const float a_max_segment_angle = a_max_sample * IM_PI * 2.0f / IM_DRAWLIST_ARCFAST_SAMPLE_MAX; + const bool a_emit_start = (a_min_segment_angle - a_min) != 0.0f; + const bool a_emit_end = (a_max - a_max_segment_angle) != 0.0f; + + _Path.reserve(_Path.Size + (a_mid_samples + 1 + (a_emit_start ? 1 : 0) + (a_emit_end ? 1 : 0))); + if (a_emit_start) + _Path.push_back(ImVec2(center.x + ImCos(a_min) * radius, center.y + ImSin(a_min) * radius)); + if (a_mid_samples > 0) + _PathArcToFastEx(center, radius, a_min_sample, a_max_sample, 0); + if (a_emit_end) + _Path.push_back(ImVec2(center.x + ImCos(a_max) * radius, center.y + ImSin(a_max) * radius)); + } + else + { + const float arc_length = ImAbs(a_max - a_min); + const int circle_segment_count = _CalcCircleAutoSegmentCount(radius); + const int arc_segment_count = ImMax((int)ImCeil(circle_segment_count * arc_length / (IM_PI * 2.0f)), (int)(2.0f * IM_PI / arc_length)); + _PathArcToN(center, radius, a_min, a_max, arc_segment_count); + } +} + +ImVec2 ImBezierCubicCalc(const ImVec2& p1, const ImVec2& p2, const ImVec2& p3, const ImVec2& p4, float t) +{ + float u = 1.0f - t; + float w1 = u * u * u; + float w2 = 3 * u * u * t; + float w3 = 3 * u * t * t; + float w4 = t * t * t; + return ImVec2(w1 * p1.x + w2 * p2.x + w3 * p3.x + w4 * p4.x, w1 * p1.y + w2 * p2.y + w3 * p3.y + w4 * p4.y); +} + +ImVec2 ImBezierQuadraticCalc(const ImVec2& p1, const ImVec2& p2, const ImVec2& p3, float t) +{ + float u = 1.0f - t; + float w1 = u * u; + float w2 = 2 * u * t; + float w3 = t * t; + return ImVec2(w1 * p1.x + w2 * p2.x + w3 * p3.x, w1 * p1.y + w2 * p2.y + w3 * p3.y); +} + +// Closely mimics ImBezierCubicClosestPointCasteljau() in imgui.cpp +static void PathBezierCubicCurveToCasteljau(ImVector* path, float x1, float y1, float x2, float y2, float x3, float y3, float x4, float y4, float tess_tol, int level) +{ + float dx = x4 - x1; + float dy = y4 - y1; + float d2 = (x2 - x4) * dy - (y2 - y4) * dx; + float d3 = (x3 - x4) * dy - (y3 - y4) * dx; + d2 = (d2 >= 0) ? d2 : -d2; + d3 = (d3 >= 0) ? d3 : -d3; + if ((d2 + d3) * (d2 + d3) < tess_tol * (dx * dx + dy * dy)) + { + path->push_back(ImVec2(x4, y4)); + } + else if (level < 10) + { + float x12 = (x1 + x2) * 0.5f, y12 = (y1 + y2) * 0.5f; + float x23 = (x2 + x3) * 0.5f, y23 = (y2 + y3) * 0.5f; + float x34 = (x3 + x4) * 0.5f, y34 = (y3 + y4) * 0.5f; + float x123 = (x12 + x23) * 0.5f, y123 = (y12 + y23) * 0.5f; + float x234 = (x23 + x34) * 0.5f, y234 = (y23 + y34) * 0.5f; + float x1234 = (x123 + x234) * 0.5f, y1234 = (y123 + y234) * 0.5f; + PathBezierCubicCurveToCasteljau(path, x1, y1, x12, y12, x123, y123, x1234, y1234, tess_tol, level + 1); + PathBezierCubicCurveToCasteljau(path, x1234, y1234, x234, y234, x34, y34, x4, y4, tess_tol, level + 1); + } +} + +static void PathBezierQuadraticCurveToCasteljau(ImVector* path, float x1, float y1, float x2, float y2, float x3, float y3, float tess_tol, int level) +{ + float dx = x3 - x1, dy = y3 - y1; + float det = (x2 - x3) * dy - (y2 - y3) * dx; + if (det * det * 4.0f < tess_tol * (dx * dx + dy * dy)) + { + path->push_back(ImVec2(x3, y3)); + } + else if (level < 10) + { + float x12 = (x1 + x2) * 0.5f, y12 = (y1 + y2) * 0.5f; + float x23 = (x2 + x3) * 0.5f, y23 = (y2 + y3) * 0.5f; + float x123 = (x12 + x23) * 0.5f, y123 = (y12 + y23) * 0.5f; + PathBezierQuadraticCurveToCasteljau(path, x1, y1, x12, y12, x123, y123, tess_tol, level + 1); + PathBezierQuadraticCurveToCasteljau(path, x123, y123, x23, y23, x3, y3, tess_tol, level + 1); + } +} + +void ImDrawList::PathBezierCubicCurveTo(const ImVec2& p2, const ImVec2& p3, const ImVec2& p4, int num_segments) +{ + ImVec2 p1 = _Path.back(); + if (num_segments == 0) + { + PathBezierCubicCurveToCasteljau(&_Path, p1.x, p1.y, p2.x, p2.y, p3.x, p3.y, p4.x, p4.y, _Data->CurveTessellationTol, 0); // Auto-tessellated + } + else + { + float t_step = 1.0f / (float)num_segments; + for (int i_step = 1; i_step <= num_segments; i_step++) + _Path.push_back(ImBezierCubicCalc(p1, p2, p3, p4, t_step * i_step)); + } +} + +void ImDrawList::PathBezierQuadraticCurveTo(const ImVec2& p2, const ImVec2& p3, int num_segments) +{ + ImVec2 p1 = _Path.back(); + if (num_segments == 0) + { + PathBezierQuadraticCurveToCasteljau(&_Path, p1.x, p1.y, p2.x, p2.y, p3.x, p3.y, _Data->CurveTessellationTol, 0);// Auto-tessellated + } + else + { + float t_step = 1.0f / (float)num_segments; + for (int i_step = 1; i_step <= num_segments; i_step++) + _Path.push_back(ImBezierQuadraticCalc(p1, p2, p3, t_step * i_step)); + } +} + +IM_STATIC_ASSERT(ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersTopLeft == (1 << 4)); +static inline ImDrawFlags FixRectCornerFlags(ImDrawFlags flags) +{ +#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_OBSOLETE_FUNCTIONS + // Legacy Support for hard coded ~0 (used to be a suggested equivalent to ImDrawCornerFlags_All) + // ~0 --> ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersAll or 0 + if (flags == ~0) + return ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersAll; + + // Legacy Support for hard coded 0x01 to 0x0F (matching 15 out of 16 old flags combinations) + // 0x01 --> ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersTopLeft (VALUE 0x01 OVERLAPS ImDrawFlags_Closed but ImDrawFlags_Closed is never valid in this path!) + // 0x02 --> ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersTopRight + // 0x03 --> ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersTopLeft | ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersTopRight + // 0x04 --> ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersBotLeft + // 0x05 --> ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersTopLeft | ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersBotLeft + // ... + // 0x0F --> ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersAll or 0 + // (See all values in ImDrawCornerFlags_) + if (flags >= 0x01 && flags <= 0x0F) + return (flags << 4); + + // We cannot support hard coded 0x00 with 'float rounding > 0.0f' --> replace with ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersNone or use 'float rounding = 0.0f' +#endif + + // If this triggers, please update your code replacing hardcoded values with new ImDrawFlags_RoundCorners* values. + // Note that ImDrawFlags_Closed (== 0x01) is an invalid flag for AddRect(), AddRectFilled(), PathRect() etc... + IM_ASSERT((flags & 0x0F) == 0 && "Misuse of legacy hardcoded ImDrawCornerFlags values!"); + + if ((flags & ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersMask_) == 0) + flags |= ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersAll; + + return flags; +} + +void ImDrawList::PathRect(const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& b, float rounding, ImDrawFlags flags) +{ + flags = FixRectCornerFlags(flags); + rounding = ImMin(rounding, ImFabs(b.x - a.x) * ( ((flags & ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersTop) == ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersTop) || ((flags & ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersBottom) == ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersBottom) ? 0.5f : 1.0f ) - 1.0f); + rounding = ImMin(rounding, ImFabs(b.y - a.y) * ( ((flags & ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersLeft) == ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersLeft) || ((flags & ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersRight) == ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersRight) ? 0.5f : 1.0f ) - 1.0f); + + if (rounding <= 0.0f || (flags & ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersMask_) == ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersNone) + { + PathLineTo(a); + PathLineTo(ImVec2(b.x, a.y)); + PathLineTo(b); + PathLineTo(ImVec2(a.x, b.y)); + } + else + { + const float rounding_tl = (flags & ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersTopLeft) ? rounding : 0.0f; + const float rounding_tr = (flags & ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersTopRight) ? rounding : 0.0f; + const float rounding_br = (flags & ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersBottomRight) ? rounding : 0.0f; + const float rounding_bl = (flags & ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersBottomLeft) ? rounding : 0.0f; + PathArcToFast(ImVec2(a.x + rounding_tl, a.y + rounding_tl), rounding_tl, 6, 9); + PathArcToFast(ImVec2(b.x - rounding_tr, a.y + rounding_tr), rounding_tr, 9, 12); + PathArcToFast(ImVec2(b.x - rounding_br, b.y - rounding_br), rounding_br, 0, 3); + PathArcToFast(ImVec2(a.x + rounding_bl, b.y - rounding_bl), rounding_bl, 3, 6); + } +} + +void ImDrawList::AddLine(const ImVec2& p1, const ImVec2& p2, ImU32 col, float thickness) +{ + if ((col & IM_COL32_A_MASK) == 0) + return; + PathLineTo(p1 + ImVec2(0.5f, 0.5f)); + PathLineTo(p2 + ImVec2(0.5f, 0.5f)); + PathStroke(col, 0, thickness); +} + +// p_min = upper-left, p_max = lower-right +// Note we don't render 1 pixels sized rectangles properly. +void ImDrawList::AddRect(const ImVec2& p_min, const ImVec2& p_max, ImU32 col, float rounding, ImDrawFlags flags, float thickness) +{ + if ((col & IM_COL32_A_MASK) == 0) + return; + if (Flags & ImDrawListFlags_AntiAliasedLines) + PathRect(p_min + ImVec2(0.50f, 0.50f), p_max - ImVec2(0.50f, 0.50f), rounding, flags); + else + PathRect(p_min + ImVec2(0.50f, 0.50f), p_max - ImVec2(0.49f, 0.49f), rounding, flags); // Better looking lower-right corner and rounded non-AA shapes. + PathStroke(col, ImDrawFlags_Closed, thickness); +} + +void ImDrawList::AddRectFilled(const ImVec2& p_min, const ImVec2& p_max, ImU32 col, float rounding, ImDrawFlags flags) +{ + if ((col & IM_COL32_A_MASK) == 0) + return; + if (rounding <= 0.0f || (flags & ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersMask_) == ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersNone) + { + PrimReserve(6, 4); + PrimRect(p_min, p_max, col); + } + else + { + PathRect(p_min, p_max, rounding, flags); + PathFillConvex(col); + } +} + +// p_min = upper-left, p_max = lower-right +void ImDrawList::AddRectFilledMultiColor(const ImVec2& p_min, const ImVec2& p_max, ImU32 col_upr_left, ImU32 col_upr_right, ImU32 col_bot_right, ImU32 col_bot_left) +{ + if (((col_upr_left | col_upr_right | col_bot_right | col_bot_left) & IM_COL32_A_MASK) == 0) + return; + + const ImVec2 uv = _Data->TexUvWhitePixel; + PrimReserve(6, 4); + PrimWriteIdx((ImDrawIdx)(_VtxCurrentIdx)); PrimWriteIdx((ImDrawIdx)(_VtxCurrentIdx + 1)); PrimWriteIdx((ImDrawIdx)(_VtxCurrentIdx + 2)); + PrimWriteIdx((ImDrawIdx)(_VtxCurrentIdx)); PrimWriteIdx((ImDrawIdx)(_VtxCurrentIdx + 2)); PrimWriteIdx((ImDrawIdx)(_VtxCurrentIdx + 3)); + PrimWriteVtx(p_min, uv, col_upr_left); + PrimWriteVtx(ImVec2(p_max.x, p_min.y), uv, col_upr_right); + PrimWriteVtx(p_max, uv, col_bot_right); + PrimWriteVtx(ImVec2(p_min.x, p_max.y), uv, col_bot_left); +} + +void ImDrawList::AddQuad(const ImVec2& p1, const ImVec2& p2, const ImVec2& p3, const ImVec2& p4, ImU32 col, float thickness) +{ + if ((col & IM_COL32_A_MASK) == 0) + return; + + PathLineTo(p1); + PathLineTo(p2); + PathLineTo(p3); + PathLineTo(p4); + PathStroke(col, ImDrawFlags_Closed, thickness); +} + +void ImDrawList::AddQuadFilled(const ImVec2& p1, const ImVec2& p2, const ImVec2& p3, const ImVec2& p4, ImU32 col) +{ + if ((col & IM_COL32_A_MASK) == 0) + return; + + PathLineTo(p1); + PathLineTo(p2); + PathLineTo(p3); + PathLineTo(p4); + PathFillConvex(col); +} + +void ImDrawList::AddTriangle(const ImVec2& p1, const ImVec2& p2, const ImVec2& p3, ImU32 col, float thickness) +{ + if ((col & IM_COL32_A_MASK) == 0) + return; + + PathLineTo(p1); + PathLineTo(p2); + PathLineTo(p3); + PathStroke(col, ImDrawFlags_Closed, thickness); +} + +void ImDrawList::AddTriangleFilled(const ImVec2& p1, const ImVec2& p2, const ImVec2& p3, ImU32 col) +{ + if ((col & IM_COL32_A_MASK) == 0) + return; + + PathLineTo(p1); + PathLineTo(p2); + PathLineTo(p3); + PathFillConvex(col); +} + +void ImDrawList::AddCircle(const ImVec2& center, float radius, ImU32 col, int num_segments, float thickness) +{ + if ((col & IM_COL32_A_MASK) == 0 || radius <= 0.0f) + return; + + if (num_segments <= 0) + { + // Use arc with automatic segment count + _PathArcToFastEx(center, radius - 0.5f, 0, IM_DRAWLIST_ARCFAST_SAMPLE_MAX, 0); + _Path.Size--; + } + else + { + // Explicit segment count (still clamp to avoid drawing insanely tessellated shapes) + num_segments = ImClamp(num_segments, 3, IM_DRAWLIST_CIRCLE_AUTO_SEGMENT_MAX); + + // Because we are filling a closed shape we remove 1 from the count of segments/points + const float a_max = (IM_PI * 2.0f) * ((float)num_segments - 1.0f) / (float)num_segments; + PathArcTo(center, radius - 0.5f, 0.0f, a_max, num_segments - 1); + } + + PathStroke(col, ImDrawFlags_Closed, thickness); +} + +void ImDrawList::AddCircleFilled(const ImVec2& center, float radius, ImU32 col, int num_segments) +{ + if ((col & IM_COL32_A_MASK) == 0 || radius <= 0.0f) + return; + + if (num_segments <= 0) + { + // Use arc with automatic segment count + _PathArcToFastEx(center, radius, 0, IM_DRAWLIST_ARCFAST_SAMPLE_MAX, 0); + _Path.Size--; + } + else + { + // Explicit segment count (still clamp to avoid drawing insanely tessellated shapes) + num_segments = ImClamp(num_segments, 3, IM_DRAWLIST_CIRCLE_AUTO_SEGMENT_MAX); + + // Because we are filling a closed shape we remove 1 from the count of segments/points + const float a_max = (IM_PI * 2.0f) * ((float)num_segments - 1.0f) / (float)num_segments; + PathArcTo(center, radius, 0.0f, a_max, num_segments - 1); + } + + PathFillConvex(col); +} + +// Guaranteed to honor 'num_segments' +void ImDrawList::AddNgon(const ImVec2& center, float radius, ImU32 col, int num_segments, float thickness) +{ + if ((col & IM_COL32_A_MASK) == 0 || num_segments <= 2) + return; + + // Because we are filling a closed shape we remove 1 from the count of segments/points + const float a_max = (IM_PI * 2.0f) * ((float)num_segments - 1.0f) / (float)num_segments; + PathArcTo(center, radius - 0.5f, 0.0f, a_max, num_segments - 1); + PathStroke(col, ImDrawFlags_Closed, thickness); +} + +// Guaranteed to honor 'num_segments' +void ImDrawList::AddNgonFilled(const ImVec2& center, float radius, ImU32 col, int num_segments) +{ + if ((col & IM_COL32_A_MASK) == 0 || num_segments <= 2) + return; + + // Because we are filling a closed shape we remove 1 from the count of segments/points + const float a_max = (IM_PI * 2.0f) * ((float)num_segments - 1.0f) / (float)num_segments; + PathArcTo(center, radius, 0.0f, a_max, num_segments - 1); + PathFillConvex(col); +} + +// Cubic Bezier takes 4 controls points +void ImDrawList::AddBezierCubic(const ImVec2& p1, const ImVec2& p2, const ImVec2& p3, const ImVec2& p4, ImU32 col, float thickness, int num_segments) +{ + if ((col & IM_COL32_A_MASK) == 0) + return; + + PathLineTo(p1); + PathBezierCubicCurveTo(p2, p3, p4, num_segments); + PathStroke(col, 0, thickness); +} + +// Quadratic Bezier takes 3 controls points +void ImDrawList::AddBezierQuadratic(const ImVec2& p1, const ImVec2& p2, const ImVec2& p3, ImU32 col, float thickness, int num_segments) +{ + if ((col & IM_COL32_A_MASK) == 0) + return; + + PathLineTo(p1); + PathBezierQuadraticCurveTo(p2, p3, num_segments); + PathStroke(col, 0, thickness); +} + +void ImDrawList::AddText(const ImFont* font, float font_size, const ImVec2& pos, ImU32 col, const char* text_begin, const char* text_end, float wrap_width, const ImVec4* cpu_fine_clip_rect) +{ + if ((col & IM_COL32_A_MASK) == 0) + return; + + if (text_end == NULL) + text_end = text_begin + strlen(text_begin); + if (text_begin == text_end) + return; + + // Pull default font/size from the shared ImDrawListSharedData instance + if (font == NULL) + font = _Data->Font; + if (font_size == 0.0f) + font_size = _Data->FontSize; + + IM_ASSERT(font->ContainerAtlas->TexID == _CmdHeader.TextureId); // Use high-level ImGui::PushFont() or low-level ImDrawList::PushTextureId() to change font. + + ImVec4 clip_rect = _CmdHeader.ClipRect; + if (cpu_fine_clip_rect) + { + clip_rect.x = ImMax(clip_rect.x, cpu_fine_clip_rect->x); + clip_rect.y = ImMax(clip_rect.y, cpu_fine_clip_rect->y); + clip_rect.z = ImMin(clip_rect.z, cpu_fine_clip_rect->z); + clip_rect.w = ImMin(clip_rect.w, cpu_fine_clip_rect->w); + } + font->RenderText(this, font_size, pos, col, clip_rect, text_begin, text_end, wrap_width, cpu_fine_clip_rect != NULL); +} + +void ImDrawList::AddText(const ImVec2& pos, ImU32 col, const char* text_begin, const char* text_end) +{ + AddText(NULL, 0.0f, pos, col, text_begin, text_end); +} + +void ImDrawList::AddImage(ImTextureID user_texture_id, const ImVec2& p_min, const ImVec2& p_max, const ImVec2& uv_min, const ImVec2& uv_max, ImU32 col) +{ + if ((col & IM_COL32_A_MASK) == 0) + return; + + const bool push_texture_id = user_texture_id != _CmdHeader.TextureId; + if (push_texture_id) + PushTextureID(user_texture_id); + + PrimReserve(6, 4); + PrimRectUV(p_min, p_max, uv_min, uv_max, col); + + if (push_texture_id) + PopTextureID(); +} + +void ImDrawList::AddImageQuad(ImTextureID user_texture_id, const ImVec2& p1, const ImVec2& p2, const ImVec2& p3, const ImVec2& p4, const ImVec2& uv1, const ImVec2& uv2, const ImVec2& uv3, const ImVec2& uv4, ImU32 col) +{ + if ((col & IM_COL32_A_MASK) == 0) + return; + + const bool push_texture_id = user_texture_id != _CmdHeader.TextureId; + if (push_texture_id) + PushTextureID(user_texture_id); + + PrimReserve(6, 4); + PrimQuadUV(p1, p2, p3, p4, uv1, uv2, uv3, uv4, col); + + if (push_texture_id) + PopTextureID(); +} + +void ImDrawList::AddImageRounded(ImTextureID user_texture_id, const ImVec2& p_min, const ImVec2& p_max, const ImVec2& uv_min, const ImVec2& uv_max, ImU32 col, float rounding, ImDrawFlags flags) +{ + if ((col & IM_COL32_A_MASK) == 0) + return; + + flags = FixRectCornerFlags(flags); + if (rounding <= 0.0f || (flags & ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersMask_) == ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersNone) + { + AddImage(user_texture_id, p_min, p_max, uv_min, uv_max, col); + return; + } + + const bool push_texture_id = user_texture_id != _CmdHeader.TextureId; + if (push_texture_id) + PushTextureID(user_texture_id); + + int vert_start_idx = VtxBuffer.Size; + PathRect(p_min, p_max, rounding, flags); + PathFillConvex(col); + int vert_end_idx = VtxBuffer.Size; + ImGui::ShadeVertsLinearUV(this, vert_start_idx, vert_end_idx, p_min, p_max, uv_min, uv_max, true); + + if (push_texture_id) + PopTextureID(); +} + + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] ImDrawListSplitter +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// FIXME: This may be a little confusing, trying to be a little too low-level/optimal instead of just doing vector swap.. +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +void ImDrawListSplitter::ClearFreeMemory() +{ + for (int i = 0; i < _Channels.Size; i++) + { + if (i == _Current) + memset(&_Channels[i], 0, sizeof(_Channels[i])); // Current channel is a copy of CmdBuffer/IdxBuffer, don't destruct again + _Channels[i]._CmdBuffer.clear(); + _Channels[i]._IdxBuffer.clear(); + } + _Current = 0; + _Count = 1; + _Channels.clear(); +} + +void ImDrawListSplitter::Split(ImDrawList* draw_list, int channels_count) +{ + IM_UNUSED(draw_list); + IM_ASSERT(_Current == 0 && _Count <= 1 && "Nested channel splitting is not supported. Please use separate instances of ImDrawListSplitter."); + int old_channels_count = _Channels.Size; + if (old_channels_count < channels_count) + { + _Channels.reserve(channels_count); // Avoid over reserving since this is likely to stay stable + _Channels.resize(channels_count); + } + _Count = channels_count; + + // Channels[] (24/32 bytes each) hold storage that we'll swap with draw_list->_CmdBuffer/_IdxBuffer + // The content of Channels[0] at this point doesn't matter. We clear it to make state tidy in a debugger but we don't strictly need to. + // When we switch to the next channel, we'll copy draw_list->_CmdBuffer/_IdxBuffer into Channels[0] and then Channels[1] into draw_list->CmdBuffer/_IdxBuffer + memset(&_Channels[0], 0, sizeof(ImDrawChannel)); + for (int i = 1; i < channels_count; i++) + { + if (i >= old_channels_count) + { + IM_PLACEMENT_NEW(&_Channels[i]) ImDrawChannel(); + } + else + { + _Channels[i]._CmdBuffer.resize(0); + _Channels[i]._IdxBuffer.resize(0); + } + } +} + +void ImDrawListSplitter::Merge(ImDrawList* draw_list) +{ + // Note that we never use or rely on _Channels.Size because it is merely a buffer that we never shrink back to 0 to keep all sub-buffers ready for use. + if (_Count <= 1) + return; + + SetCurrentChannel(draw_list, 0); + draw_list->_PopUnusedDrawCmd(); + + // Calculate our final buffer sizes. Also fix the incorrect IdxOffset values in each command. + int new_cmd_buffer_count = 0; + int new_idx_buffer_count = 0; + ImDrawCmd* last_cmd = (_Count > 0 && draw_list->CmdBuffer.Size > 0) ? &draw_list->CmdBuffer.back() : NULL; + int idx_offset = last_cmd ? last_cmd->IdxOffset + last_cmd->ElemCount : 0; + for (int i = 1; i < _Count; i++) + { + ImDrawChannel& ch = _Channels[i]; + + // Equivalent of PopUnusedDrawCmd() for this channel's cmdbuffer and except we don't need to test for UserCallback. + if (ch._CmdBuffer.Size > 0 && ch._CmdBuffer.back().ElemCount == 0) + ch._CmdBuffer.pop_back(); + + if (ch._CmdBuffer.Size > 0 && last_cmd != NULL) + { + ImDrawCmd* next_cmd = &ch._CmdBuffer[0]; + if (ImDrawCmd_HeaderCompare(last_cmd, next_cmd) == 0 && last_cmd->UserCallback == NULL && next_cmd->UserCallback == NULL) + { + // Merge previous channel last draw command with current channel first draw command if matching. + last_cmd->ElemCount += next_cmd->ElemCount; + idx_offset += next_cmd->ElemCount; + ch._CmdBuffer.erase(ch._CmdBuffer.Data); // FIXME-OPT: Improve for multiple merges. + } + } + if (ch._CmdBuffer.Size > 0) + last_cmd = &ch._CmdBuffer.back(); + new_cmd_buffer_count += ch._CmdBuffer.Size; + new_idx_buffer_count += ch._IdxBuffer.Size; + for (int cmd_n = 0; cmd_n < ch._CmdBuffer.Size; cmd_n++) + { + ch._CmdBuffer.Data[cmd_n].IdxOffset = idx_offset; + idx_offset += ch._CmdBuffer.Data[cmd_n].ElemCount; + } + } + draw_list->CmdBuffer.resize(draw_list->CmdBuffer.Size + new_cmd_buffer_count); + draw_list->IdxBuffer.resize(draw_list->IdxBuffer.Size + new_idx_buffer_count); + + // Write commands and indices in order (they are fairly small structures, we don't copy vertices only indices) + ImDrawCmd* cmd_write = draw_list->CmdBuffer.Data + draw_list->CmdBuffer.Size - new_cmd_buffer_count; + ImDrawIdx* idx_write = draw_list->IdxBuffer.Data + draw_list->IdxBuffer.Size - new_idx_buffer_count; + for (int i = 1; i < _Count; i++) + { + ImDrawChannel& ch = _Channels[i]; + if (int sz = ch._CmdBuffer.Size) { memcpy(cmd_write, ch._CmdBuffer.Data, sz * sizeof(ImDrawCmd)); cmd_write += sz; } + if (int sz = ch._IdxBuffer.Size) { memcpy(idx_write, ch._IdxBuffer.Data, sz * sizeof(ImDrawIdx)); idx_write += sz; } + } + draw_list->_IdxWritePtr = idx_write; + + // Ensure there's always a non-callback draw command trailing the command-buffer + if (draw_list->CmdBuffer.Size == 0 || draw_list->CmdBuffer.back().UserCallback != NULL) + draw_list->AddDrawCmd(); + + // If current command is used with different settings we need to add a new command + ImDrawCmd* curr_cmd = &draw_list->CmdBuffer.Data[draw_list->CmdBuffer.Size - 1]; + if (curr_cmd->ElemCount == 0) + ImDrawCmd_HeaderCopy(curr_cmd, &draw_list->_CmdHeader); // Copy ClipRect, TextureId, VtxOffset + else if (ImDrawCmd_HeaderCompare(curr_cmd, &draw_list->_CmdHeader) != 0) + draw_list->AddDrawCmd(); + + _Count = 1; +} + +void ImDrawListSplitter::SetCurrentChannel(ImDrawList* draw_list, int idx) +{ + IM_ASSERT(idx >= 0 && idx < _Count); + if (_Current == idx) + return; + + // Overwrite ImVector (12/16 bytes), four times. This is merely a silly optimization instead of doing .swap() + memcpy(&_Channels.Data[_Current]._CmdBuffer, &draw_list->CmdBuffer, sizeof(draw_list->CmdBuffer)); + memcpy(&_Channels.Data[_Current]._IdxBuffer, &draw_list->IdxBuffer, sizeof(draw_list->IdxBuffer)); + _Current = idx; + memcpy(&draw_list->CmdBuffer, &_Channels.Data[idx]._CmdBuffer, sizeof(draw_list->CmdBuffer)); + memcpy(&draw_list->IdxBuffer, &_Channels.Data[idx]._IdxBuffer, sizeof(draw_list->IdxBuffer)); + draw_list->_IdxWritePtr = draw_list->IdxBuffer.Data + draw_list->IdxBuffer.Size; + + // If current command is used with different settings we need to add a new command + ImDrawCmd* curr_cmd = (draw_list->CmdBuffer.Size == 0) ? NULL : &draw_list->CmdBuffer.Data[draw_list->CmdBuffer.Size - 1]; + if (curr_cmd == NULL) + draw_list->AddDrawCmd(); + else if (curr_cmd->ElemCount == 0) + ImDrawCmd_HeaderCopy(curr_cmd, &draw_list->_CmdHeader); // Copy ClipRect, TextureId, VtxOffset + else if (ImDrawCmd_HeaderCompare(curr_cmd, &draw_list->_CmdHeader) != 0) + draw_list->AddDrawCmd(); +} + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] ImDrawData +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// For backward compatibility: convert all buffers from indexed to de-indexed, in case you cannot render indexed. Note: this is slow and most likely a waste of resources. Always prefer indexed rendering! +void ImDrawData::DeIndexAllBuffers() +{ + ImVector new_vtx_buffer; + TotalVtxCount = TotalIdxCount = 0; + for (int i = 0; i < CmdListsCount; i++) + { + ImDrawList* cmd_list = CmdLists[i]; + if (cmd_list->IdxBuffer.empty()) + continue; + new_vtx_buffer.resize(cmd_list->IdxBuffer.Size); + for (int j = 0; j < cmd_list->IdxBuffer.Size; j++) + new_vtx_buffer[j] = cmd_list->VtxBuffer[cmd_list->IdxBuffer[j]]; + cmd_list->VtxBuffer.swap(new_vtx_buffer); + cmd_list->IdxBuffer.resize(0); + TotalVtxCount += cmd_list->VtxBuffer.Size; + } +} + +// Helper to scale the ClipRect field of each ImDrawCmd. +// Use if your final output buffer is at a different scale than draw_data->DisplaySize, +// or if there is a difference between your window resolution and framebuffer resolution. +void ImDrawData::ScaleClipRects(const ImVec2& fb_scale) +{ + for (int i = 0; i < CmdListsCount; i++) + { + ImDrawList* cmd_list = CmdLists[i]; + for (int cmd_i = 0; cmd_i < cmd_list->CmdBuffer.Size; cmd_i++) + { + ImDrawCmd* cmd = &cmd_list->CmdBuffer[cmd_i]; + cmd->ClipRect = ImVec4(cmd->ClipRect.x * fb_scale.x, cmd->ClipRect.y * fb_scale.y, cmd->ClipRect.z * fb_scale.x, cmd->ClipRect.w * fb_scale.y); + } + } +} + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Helpers ShadeVertsXXX functions +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// Generic linear color gradient, write to RGB fields, leave A untouched. +void ImGui::ShadeVertsLinearColorGradientKeepAlpha(ImDrawList* draw_list, int vert_start_idx, int vert_end_idx, ImVec2 gradient_p0, ImVec2 gradient_p1, ImU32 col0, ImU32 col1) +{ + ImVec2 gradient_extent = gradient_p1 - gradient_p0; + float gradient_inv_length2 = 1.0f / ImLengthSqr(gradient_extent); + ImDrawVert* vert_start = draw_list->VtxBuffer.Data + vert_start_idx; + ImDrawVert* vert_end = draw_list->VtxBuffer.Data + vert_end_idx; + const int col0_r = (int)(col0 >> IM_COL32_R_SHIFT) & 0xFF; + const int col0_g = (int)(col0 >> IM_COL32_G_SHIFT) & 0xFF; + const int col0_b = (int)(col0 >> IM_COL32_B_SHIFT) & 0xFF; + const int col_delta_r = ((int)(col1 >> IM_COL32_R_SHIFT) & 0xFF) - col0_r; + const int col_delta_g = ((int)(col1 >> IM_COL32_G_SHIFT) & 0xFF) - col0_g; + const int col_delta_b = ((int)(col1 >> IM_COL32_B_SHIFT) & 0xFF) - col0_b; + for (ImDrawVert* vert = vert_start; vert < vert_end; vert++) + { + float d = ImDot(vert->pos - gradient_p0, gradient_extent); + float t = ImClamp(d * gradient_inv_length2, 0.0f, 1.0f); + int r = (int)(col0_r + col_delta_r * t); + int g = (int)(col0_g + col_delta_g * t); + int b = (int)(col0_b + col_delta_b * t); + vert->col = (r << IM_COL32_R_SHIFT) | (g << IM_COL32_G_SHIFT) | (b << IM_COL32_B_SHIFT) | (vert->col & IM_COL32_A_MASK); + } +} + +// Distribute UV over (a, b) rectangle +void ImGui::ShadeVertsLinearUV(ImDrawList* draw_list, int vert_start_idx, int vert_end_idx, const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& b, const ImVec2& uv_a, const ImVec2& uv_b, bool clamp) +{ + const ImVec2 size = b - a; + const ImVec2 uv_size = uv_b - uv_a; + const ImVec2 scale = ImVec2( + size.x != 0.0f ? (uv_size.x / size.x) : 0.0f, + size.y != 0.0f ? (uv_size.y / size.y) : 0.0f); + + ImDrawVert* vert_start = draw_list->VtxBuffer.Data + vert_start_idx; + ImDrawVert* vert_end = draw_list->VtxBuffer.Data + vert_end_idx; + if (clamp) + { + const ImVec2 min = ImMin(uv_a, uv_b); + const ImVec2 max = ImMax(uv_a, uv_b); + for (ImDrawVert* vertex = vert_start; vertex < vert_end; ++vertex) + vertex->uv = ImClamp(uv_a + ImMul(ImVec2(vertex->pos.x, vertex->pos.y) - a, scale), min, max); + } + else + { + for (ImDrawVert* vertex = vert_start; vertex < vert_end; ++vertex) + vertex->uv = uv_a + ImMul(ImVec2(vertex->pos.x, vertex->pos.y) - a, scale); + } +} + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] ImFontConfig +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +ImFontConfig::ImFontConfig() +{ + memset(this, 0, sizeof(*this)); + FontDataOwnedByAtlas = true; + OversampleH = 3; // FIXME: 2 may be a better default? + OversampleV = 1; + GlyphMaxAdvanceX = FLT_MAX; + RasterizerMultiply = 1.0f; + EllipsisChar = (ImWchar)-1; +} + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] ImFontAtlas +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// A work of art lies ahead! (. = white layer, X = black layer, others are blank) +// The 2x2 white texels on the top left are the ones we'll use everywhere in Dear ImGui to render filled shapes. +const int FONT_ATLAS_DEFAULT_TEX_DATA_W = 108; // Actual texture will be 2 times that + 1 spacing. +const int FONT_ATLAS_DEFAULT_TEX_DATA_H = 27; +static const char FONT_ATLAS_DEFAULT_TEX_DATA_PIXELS[FONT_ATLAS_DEFAULT_TEX_DATA_W * FONT_ATLAS_DEFAULT_TEX_DATA_H + 1] = +{ + "..- -XXXXXXX- X - X -XXXXXXX - XXXXXXX- XX " + "..- -X.....X- X.X - X.X -X.....X - X.....X- X..X " + "--- -XXX.XXX- X...X - X...X -X....X - X....X- X..X " + "X - X.X - X.....X - X.....X -X...X - X...X- X..X " + "XX - X.X -X.......X- X.......X -X..X.X - X.X..X- X..X " + "X.X - X.X -XXXX.XXXX- XXXX.XXXX -X.X X.X - X.X X.X- X..XXX " + "X..X - X.X - X.X - X.X -XX X.X - X.X XX- X..X..XXX " + "X...X - X.X - X.X - XX X.X XX - X.X - X.X - X..X..X..XX " + "X....X - X.X - X.X - X.X X.X X.X - X.X - X.X - X..X..X..X.X " + "X.....X - X.X - X.X - X..X X.X X..X - X.X - X.X -XXX X..X..X..X..X" + "X......X - X.X - X.X - X...XXXXXX.XXXXXX...X - X.X XX-XX X.X -X..XX........X..X" + "X.......X - X.X - X.X -X.....................X- X.X X.X-X.X X.X -X...X...........X" + "X........X - X.X - X.X - X...XXXXXX.XXXXXX...X - X.X..X-X..X.X - X..............X" + "X.........X -XXX.XXX- X.X - X..X X.X X..X - X...X-X...X - X.............X" + "X..........X-X.....X- X.X - X.X X.X X.X - X....X-X....X - X.............X" + "X......XXXXX-XXXXXXX- X.X - XX X.X XX - X.....X-X.....X - X............X" + "X...X..X --------- X.X - X.X - XXXXXXX-XXXXXXX - X...........X " + "X..X X..X - -XXXX.XXXX- XXXX.XXXX ------------------------------------- X..........X " + "X.X X..X - -X.......X- X.......X - XX XX - - X..........X " + "XX X..X - - X.....X - X.....X - X.X X.X - - X........X " + " X..X - X...X - X...X - X..X X..X - - X........X " + " XX - X.X - X.X - X...XXXXXXXXXXXXX...X - - XXXXXXXXXX " + "------------ - X - X -X.....................X- ------------------" + " ----------------------------------- X...XXXXXXXXXXXXX...X - " + " - X..X X..X - " + " - X.X X.X - " + " - XX XX - " +}; + +static const ImVec2 FONT_ATLAS_DEFAULT_TEX_CURSOR_DATA[ImGuiMouseCursor_COUNT][3] = +{ + // Pos ........ Size ......... Offset ...... + { ImVec2( 0,3), ImVec2(12,19), ImVec2( 0, 0) }, // ImGuiMouseCursor_Arrow + { ImVec2(13,0), ImVec2( 7,16), ImVec2( 1, 8) }, // ImGuiMouseCursor_TextInput + { ImVec2(31,0), ImVec2(23,23), ImVec2(11,11) }, // ImGuiMouseCursor_ResizeAll + { ImVec2(21,0), ImVec2( 9,23), ImVec2( 4,11) }, // ImGuiMouseCursor_ResizeNS + { ImVec2(55,18),ImVec2(23, 9), ImVec2(11, 4) }, // ImGuiMouseCursor_ResizeEW + { ImVec2(73,0), ImVec2(17,17), ImVec2( 8, 8) }, // ImGuiMouseCursor_ResizeNESW + { ImVec2(55,0), ImVec2(17,17), ImVec2( 8, 8) }, // ImGuiMouseCursor_ResizeNWSE + { ImVec2(91,0), ImVec2(17,22), ImVec2( 5, 0) }, // ImGuiMouseCursor_Hand +}; + +ImFontAtlas::ImFontAtlas() +{ + memset(this, 0, sizeof(*this)); + TexGlyphPadding = 1; + PackIdMouseCursors = PackIdLines = -1; +} + +ImFontAtlas::~ImFontAtlas() +{ + IM_ASSERT(!Locked && "Cannot modify a locked ImFontAtlas between NewFrame() and EndFrame/Render()!"); + Clear(); +} + +void ImFontAtlas::ClearInputData() +{ + IM_ASSERT(!Locked && "Cannot modify a locked ImFontAtlas between NewFrame() and EndFrame/Render()!"); + for (int i = 0; i < ConfigData.Size; i++) + if (ConfigData[i].FontData && ConfigData[i].FontDataOwnedByAtlas) + { + IM_FREE(ConfigData[i].FontData); + ConfigData[i].FontData = NULL; + } + + // When clearing this we lose access to the font name and other information used to build the font. + for (int i = 0; i < Fonts.Size; i++) + if (Fonts[i]->ConfigData >= ConfigData.Data && Fonts[i]->ConfigData < ConfigData.Data + ConfigData.Size) + { + Fonts[i]->ConfigData = NULL; + Fonts[i]->ConfigDataCount = 0; + } + ConfigData.clear(); + CustomRects.clear(); + PackIdMouseCursors = PackIdLines = -1; + TexReady = false; +} + +void ImFontAtlas::ClearTexData() +{ + IM_ASSERT(!Locked && "Cannot modify a locked ImFontAtlas between NewFrame() and EndFrame/Render()!"); + if (TexPixelsAlpha8) + IM_FREE(TexPixelsAlpha8); + if (TexPixelsRGBA32) + IM_FREE(TexPixelsRGBA32); + TexPixelsAlpha8 = NULL; + TexPixelsRGBA32 = NULL; + TexPixelsUseColors = false; + // Important: we leave TexReady untouched +} + +void ImFontAtlas::ClearFonts() +{ + IM_ASSERT(!Locked && "Cannot modify a locked ImFontAtlas between NewFrame() and EndFrame/Render()!"); + Fonts.clear_delete(); + TexReady = false; +} + +void ImFontAtlas::Clear() +{ + ClearInputData(); + ClearTexData(); + ClearFonts(); +} + +void ImFontAtlas::GetTexDataAsAlpha8(unsigned char** out_pixels, int* out_width, int* out_height, int* out_bytes_per_pixel) +{ + // Build atlas on demand + if (TexPixelsAlpha8 == NULL) + Build(); + + *out_pixels = TexPixelsAlpha8; + if (out_width) *out_width = TexWidth; + if (out_height) *out_height = TexHeight; + if (out_bytes_per_pixel) *out_bytes_per_pixel = 1; +} + +void ImFontAtlas::GetTexDataAsRGBA32(unsigned char** out_pixels, int* out_width, int* out_height, int* out_bytes_per_pixel) +{ + // Convert to RGBA32 format on demand + // Although it is likely to be the most commonly used format, our font rendering is 1 channel / 8 bpp + if (!TexPixelsRGBA32) + { + unsigned char* pixels = NULL; + GetTexDataAsAlpha8(&pixels, NULL, NULL); + if (pixels) + { + TexPixelsRGBA32 = (unsigned int*)IM_ALLOC((size_t)TexWidth * (size_t)TexHeight * 4); + const unsigned char* src = pixels; + unsigned int* dst = TexPixelsRGBA32; + for (int n = TexWidth * TexHeight; n > 0; n--) + *dst++ = IM_COL32(255, 255, 255, (unsigned int)(*src++)); + } + } + + *out_pixels = (unsigned char*)TexPixelsRGBA32; + if (out_width) *out_width = TexWidth; + if (out_height) *out_height = TexHeight; + if (out_bytes_per_pixel) *out_bytes_per_pixel = 4; +} + +ImFont* ImFontAtlas::AddFont(const ImFontConfig* font_cfg) +{ + IM_ASSERT(!Locked && "Cannot modify a locked ImFontAtlas between NewFrame() and EndFrame/Render()!"); + IM_ASSERT(font_cfg->FontData != NULL && font_cfg->FontDataSize > 0); + IM_ASSERT(font_cfg->SizePixels > 0.0f); + + // Create new font + if (!font_cfg->MergeMode) + Fonts.push_back(IM_NEW(ImFont)); + else + IM_ASSERT(!Fonts.empty() && "Cannot use MergeMode for the first font"); // When using MergeMode make sure that a font has already been added before. You can use ImGui::GetIO().Fonts->AddFontDefault() to add the default imgui font. + + ConfigData.push_back(*font_cfg); + ImFontConfig& new_font_cfg = ConfigData.back(); + if (new_font_cfg.DstFont == NULL) + new_font_cfg.DstFont = Fonts.back(); + if (!new_font_cfg.FontDataOwnedByAtlas) + { + new_font_cfg.FontData = IM_ALLOC(new_font_cfg.FontDataSize); + new_font_cfg.FontDataOwnedByAtlas = true; + memcpy(new_font_cfg.FontData, font_cfg->FontData, (size_t)new_font_cfg.FontDataSize); + } + + if (new_font_cfg.DstFont->EllipsisChar == (ImWchar)-1) + new_font_cfg.DstFont->EllipsisChar = font_cfg->EllipsisChar; + + // Invalidate texture + TexReady = false; + ClearTexData(); + return new_font_cfg.DstFont; +} + +// Default font TTF is compressed with stb_compress then base85 encoded (see misc/fonts/binary_to_compressed_c.cpp for encoder) +static unsigned int stb_decompress_length(const unsigned char* input); +static unsigned int stb_decompress(unsigned char* output, const unsigned char* input, unsigned int length); +static const char* GetDefaultCompressedFontDataTTFBase85(); +static unsigned int Decode85Byte(char c) { return c >= '\\' ? c-36 : c-35; } +static void Decode85(const unsigned char* src, unsigned char* dst) +{ + while (*src) + { + unsigned int tmp = Decode85Byte(src[0]) + 85 * (Decode85Byte(src[1]) + 85 * (Decode85Byte(src[2]) + 85 * (Decode85Byte(src[3]) + 85 * Decode85Byte(src[4])))); + dst[0] = ((tmp >> 0) & 0xFF); dst[1] = ((tmp >> 8) & 0xFF); dst[2] = ((tmp >> 16) & 0xFF); dst[3] = ((tmp >> 24) & 0xFF); // We can't assume little-endianness. + src += 5; + dst += 4; + } +} + +// Load embedded ProggyClean.ttf at size 13, disable oversampling +ImFont* ImFontAtlas::AddFontDefault(const ImFontConfig* font_cfg_template) +{ + ImFontConfig font_cfg = font_cfg_template ? *font_cfg_template : ImFontConfig(); + if (!font_cfg_template) + { + font_cfg.OversampleH = font_cfg.OversampleV = 1; + font_cfg.PixelSnapH = true; + } + if (font_cfg.SizePixels <= 0.0f) + font_cfg.SizePixels = 13.0f * 1.0f; + if (font_cfg.Name[0] == '\0') + ImFormatString(font_cfg.Name, IM_ARRAYSIZE(font_cfg.Name), "ProggyClean.ttf, %dpx", (int)font_cfg.SizePixels); + font_cfg.EllipsisChar = (ImWchar)0x0085; + font_cfg.GlyphOffset.y = 1.0f * IM_FLOOR(font_cfg.SizePixels / 13.0f); // Add +1 offset per 13 units + + const char* ttf_compressed_base85 = GetDefaultCompressedFontDataTTFBase85(); + const ImWchar* glyph_ranges = font_cfg.GlyphRanges != NULL ? font_cfg.GlyphRanges : GetGlyphRangesDefault(); + ImFont* font = AddFontFromMemoryCompressedBase85TTF(ttf_compressed_base85, font_cfg.SizePixels, &font_cfg, glyph_ranges); + return font; +} + +ImFont* ImFontAtlas::AddFontFromFileTTF(const char* filename, float size_pixels, const ImFontConfig* font_cfg_template, const ImWchar* glyph_ranges) +{ + IM_ASSERT(!Locked && "Cannot modify a locked ImFontAtlas between NewFrame() and EndFrame/Render()!"); + size_t data_size = 0; + void* data = ImFileLoadToMemory(filename, "rb", &data_size, 0); + if (!data) + { + IM_ASSERT_USER_ERROR(0, "Could not load font file!"); + return NULL; + } + ImFontConfig font_cfg = font_cfg_template ? *font_cfg_template : ImFontConfig(); + if (font_cfg.Name[0] == '\0') + { + // Store a short copy of filename into into the font name for convenience + const char* p; + for (p = filename + strlen(filename); p > filename && p[-1] != '/' && p[-1] != '\\'; p--) {} + ImFormatString(font_cfg.Name, IM_ARRAYSIZE(font_cfg.Name), "%s, %.0fpx", p, size_pixels); + } + return AddFontFromMemoryTTF(data, (int)data_size, size_pixels, &font_cfg, glyph_ranges); +} + +// NB: Transfer ownership of 'ttf_data' to ImFontAtlas, unless font_cfg_template->FontDataOwnedByAtlas == false. Owned TTF buffer will be deleted after Build(). +ImFont* ImFontAtlas::AddFontFromMemoryTTF(void* ttf_data, int ttf_size, float size_pixels, const ImFontConfig* font_cfg_template, const ImWchar* glyph_ranges) +{ + IM_ASSERT(!Locked && "Cannot modify a locked ImFontAtlas between NewFrame() and EndFrame/Render()!"); + ImFontConfig font_cfg = font_cfg_template ? *font_cfg_template : ImFontConfig(); + IM_ASSERT(font_cfg.FontData == NULL); + font_cfg.FontData = ttf_data; + font_cfg.FontDataSize = ttf_size; + font_cfg.SizePixels = size_pixels > 0.0f ? size_pixels : font_cfg.SizePixels; + if (glyph_ranges) + font_cfg.GlyphRanges = glyph_ranges; + return AddFont(&font_cfg); +} + +ImFont* ImFontAtlas::AddFontFromMemoryCompressedTTF(const void* compressed_ttf_data, int compressed_ttf_size, float size_pixels, const ImFontConfig* font_cfg_template, const ImWchar* glyph_ranges) +{ + const unsigned int buf_decompressed_size = stb_decompress_length((const unsigned char*)compressed_ttf_data); + unsigned char* buf_decompressed_data = (unsigned char*)IM_ALLOC(buf_decompressed_size); + stb_decompress(buf_decompressed_data, (const unsigned char*)compressed_ttf_data, (unsigned int)compressed_ttf_size); + + ImFontConfig font_cfg = font_cfg_template ? *font_cfg_template : ImFontConfig(); + IM_ASSERT(font_cfg.FontData == NULL); + font_cfg.FontDataOwnedByAtlas = true; + return AddFontFromMemoryTTF(buf_decompressed_data, (int)buf_decompressed_size, size_pixels, &font_cfg, glyph_ranges); +} + +ImFont* ImFontAtlas::AddFontFromMemoryCompressedBase85TTF(const char* compressed_ttf_data_base85, float size_pixels, const ImFontConfig* font_cfg, const ImWchar* glyph_ranges) +{ + int compressed_ttf_size = (((int)strlen(compressed_ttf_data_base85) + 4) / 5) * 4; + void* compressed_ttf = IM_ALLOC((size_t)compressed_ttf_size); + Decode85((const unsigned char*)compressed_ttf_data_base85, (unsigned char*)compressed_ttf); + ImFont* font = AddFontFromMemoryCompressedTTF(compressed_ttf, compressed_ttf_size, size_pixels, font_cfg, glyph_ranges); + IM_FREE(compressed_ttf); + return font; +} + +int ImFontAtlas::AddCustomRectRegular(int width, int height) +{ + IM_ASSERT(width > 0 && width <= 0xFFFF); + IM_ASSERT(height > 0 && height <= 0xFFFF); + ImFontAtlasCustomRect r; + r.Width = (unsigned short)width; + r.Height = (unsigned short)height; + CustomRects.push_back(r); + return CustomRects.Size - 1; // Return index +} + +int ImFontAtlas::AddCustomRectFontGlyph(ImFont* font, ImWchar id, int width, int height, float advance_x, const ImVec2& offset) +{ +#ifdef IMGUI_USE_WCHAR32 + IM_ASSERT(id <= IM_UNICODE_CODEPOINT_MAX); +#endif + IM_ASSERT(font != NULL); + IM_ASSERT(width > 0 && width <= 0xFFFF); + IM_ASSERT(height > 0 && height <= 0xFFFF); + ImFontAtlasCustomRect r; + r.Width = (unsigned short)width; + r.Height = (unsigned short)height; + r.GlyphID = id; + r.GlyphAdvanceX = advance_x; + r.GlyphOffset = offset; + r.Font = font; + CustomRects.push_back(r); + return CustomRects.Size - 1; // Return index +} + +void ImFontAtlas::CalcCustomRectUV(const ImFontAtlasCustomRect* rect, ImVec2* out_uv_min, ImVec2* out_uv_max) const +{ + IM_ASSERT(TexWidth > 0 && TexHeight > 0); // Font atlas needs to be built before we can calculate UV coordinates + IM_ASSERT(rect->IsPacked()); // Make sure the rectangle has been packed + *out_uv_min = ImVec2((float)rect->X * TexUvScale.x, (float)rect->Y * TexUvScale.y); + *out_uv_max = ImVec2((float)(rect->X + rect->Width) * TexUvScale.x, (float)(rect->Y + rect->Height) * TexUvScale.y); +} + +bool ImFontAtlas::GetMouseCursorTexData(ImGuiMouseCursor cursor_type, ImVec2* out_offset, ImVec2* out_size, ImVec2 out_uv_border[2], ImVec2 out_uv_fill[2]) +{ + if (cursor_type <= ImGuiMouseCursor_None || cursor_type >= ImGuiMouseCursor_COUNT) + return false; + if (Flags & ImFontAtlasFlags_NoMouseCursors) + return false; + + IM_ASSERT(PackIdMouseCursors != -1); + ImFontAtlasCustomRect* r = GetCustomRectByIndex(PackIdMouseCursors); + ImVec2 pos = FONT_ATLAS_DEFAULT_TEX_CURSOR_DATA[cursor_type][0] + ImVec2((float)r->X, (float)r->Y); + ImVec2 size = FONT_ATLAS_DEFAULT_TEX_CURSOR_DATA[cursor_type][1]; + *out_size = size; + *out_offset = FONT_ATLAS_DEFAULT_TEX_CURSOR_DATA[cursor_type][2]; + out_uv_border[0] = (pos) * TexUvScale; + out_uv_border[1] = (pos + size) * TexUvScale; + pos.x += FONT_ATLAS_DEFAULT_TEX_DATA_W + 1; + out_uv_fill[0] = (pos) * TexUvScale; + out_uv_fill[1] = (pos + size) * TexUvScale; + return true; +} + +bool ImFontAtlas::Build() +{ + IM_ASSERT(!Locked && "Cannot modify a locked ImFontAtlas between NewFrame() and EndFrame/Render()!"); + + // Default font is none are specified + if (ConfigData.Size == 0) + AddFontDefault(); + + // Select builder + // - Note that we do not reassign to atlas->FontBuilderIO, since it is likely to point to static data which + // may mess with some hot-reloading schemes. If you need to assign to this (for dynamic selection) AND are + // using a hot-reloading scheme that messes up static data, store your own instance of ImFontBuilderIO somewhere + // and point to it instead of pointing directly to return value of the GetBuilderXXX functions. + const ImFontBuilderIO* builder_io = FontBuilderIO; + if (builder_io == NULL) + { +#ifdef IMGUI_ENABLE_FREETYPE + builder_io = ImGuiFreeType::GetBuilderForFreeType(); +#elif defined(IMGUI_ENABLE_STB_TRUETYPE) + builder_io = ImFontAtlasGetBuilderForStbTruetype(); +#else + IM_ASSERT(0); // Invalid Build function +#endif + } + + // Build + return builder_io->FontBuilder_Build(this); +} + +void ImFontAtlasBuildMultiplyCalcLookupTable(unsigned char out_table[256], float in_brighten_factor) +{ + for (unsigned int i = 0; i < 256; i++) + { + unsigned int value = (unsigned int)(i * in_brighten_factor); + out_table[i] = value > 255 ? 255 : (value & 0xFF); + } +} + +void ImFontAtlasBuildMultiplyRectAlpha8(const unsigned char table[256], unsigned char* pixels, int x, int y, int w, int h, int stride) +{ + unsigned char* data = pixels + x + y * stride; + for (int j = h; j > 0; j--, data += stride) + for (int i = 0; i < w; i++) + data[i] = table[data[i]]; +} + +#ifdef IMGUI_ENABLE_STB_TRUETYPE +// Temporary data for one source font (multiple source fonts can be merged into one destination ImFont) +// (C++03 doesn't allow instancing ImVector<> with function-local types so we declare the type here.) +struct ImFontBuildSrcData +{ + stbtt_fontinfo FontInfo; + stbtt_pack_range PackRange; // Hold the list of codepoints to pack (essentially points to Codepoints.Data) + stbrp_rect* Rects; // Rectangle to pack. We first fill in their size and the packer will give us their position. + stbtt_packedchar* PackedChars; // Output glyphs + const ImWchar* SrcRanges; // Ranges as requested by user (user is allowed to request too much, e.g. 0x0020..0xFFFF) + int DstIndex; // Index into atlas->Fonts[] and dst_tmp_array[] + int GlyphsHighest; // Highest requested codepoint + int GlyphsCount; // Glyph count (excluding missing glyphs and glyphs already set by an earlier source font) + ImBitVector GlyphsSet; // Glyph bit map (random access, 1-bit per codepoint. This will be a maximum of 8KB) + ImVector GlyphsList; // Glyph codepoints list (flattened version of GlyphsMap) +}; + +// Temporary data for one destination ImFont* (multiple source fonts can be merged into one destination ImFont) +struct ImFontBuildDstData +{ + int SrcCount; // Number of source fonts targeting this destination font. + int GlyphsHighest; + int GlyphsCount; + ImBitVector GlyphsSet; // This is used to resolve collision when multiple sources are merged into a same destination font. +}; + +static void UnpackBitVectorToFlatIndexList(const ImBitVector* in, ImVector* out) +{ + IM_ASSERT(sizeof(in->Storage.Data[0]) == sizeof(int)); + const ImU32* it_begin = in->Storage.begin(); + const ImU32* it_end = in->Storage.end(); + for (const ImU32* it = it_begin; it < it_end; it++) + if (ImU32 entries_32 = *it) + for (ImU32 bit_n = 0; bit_n < 32; bit_n++) + if (entries_32 & ((ImU32)1 << bit_n)) + out->push_back((int)(((it - it_begin) << 5) + bit_n)); +} + +static bool ImFontAtlasBuildWithStbTruetype(ImFontAtlas* atlas) +{ + IM_ASSERT(atlas->ConfigData.Size > 0); + + ImFontAtlasBuildInit(atlas); + + // Clear atlas + atlas->TexID = (ImTextureID)NULL; + atlas->TexWidth = atlas->TexHeight = 0; + atlas->TexUvScale = ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f); + atlas->TexUvWhitePixel = ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f); + atlas->ClearTexData(); + + // Temporary storage for building + ImVector src_tmp_array; + ImVector dst_tmp_array; + src_tmp_array.resize(atlas->ConfigData.Size); + dst_tmp_array.resize(atlas->Fonts.Size); + memset(src_tmp_array.Data, 0, (size_t)src_tmp_array.size_in_bytes()); + memset(dst_tmp_array.Data, 0, (size_t)dst_tmp_array.size_in_bytes()); + + // 1. Initialize font loading structure, check font data validity + for (int src_i = 0; src_i < atlas->ConfigData.Size; src_i++) + { + ImFontBuildSrcData& src_tmp = src_tmp_array[src_i]; + ImFontConfig& cfg = atlas->ConfigData[src_i]; + IM_ASSERT(cfg.DstFont && (!cfg.DstFont->IsLoaded() || cfg.DstFont->ContainerAtlas == atlas)); + + // Find index from cfg.DstFont (we allow the user to set cfg.DstFont. Also it makes casual debugging nicer than when storing indices) + src_tmp.DstIndex = -1; + for (int output_i = 0; output_i < atlas->Fonts.Size && src_tmp.DstIndex == -1; output_i++) + if (cfg.DstFont == atlas->Fonts[output_i]) + src_tmp.DstIndex = output_i; + if (src_tmp.DstIndex == -1) + { + IM_ASSERT(src_tmp.DstIndex != -1); // cfg.DstFont not pointing within atlas->Fonts[] array? + return false; + } + // Initialize helper structure for font loading and verify that the TTF/OTF data is correct + const int font_offset = stbtt_GetFontOffsetForIndex((unsigned char*)cfg.FontData, cfg.FontNo); + IM_ASSERT(font_offset >= 0 && "FontData is incorrect, or FontNo cannot be found."); + if (!stbtt_InitFont(&src_tmp.FontInfo, (unsigned char*)cfg.FontData, font_offset)) + return false; + + // Measure highest codepoints + ImFontBuildDstData& dst_tmp = dst_tmp_array[src_tmp.DstIndex]; + src_tmp.SrcRanges = cfg.GlyphRanges ? cfg.GlyphRanges : atlas->GetGlyphRangesDefault(); + for (const ImWchar* src_range = src_tmp.SrcRanges; src_range[0] && src_range[1]; src_range += 2) + src_tmp.GlyphsHighest = ImMax(src_tmp.GlyphsHighest, (int)src_range[1]); + dst_tmp.SrcCount++; + dst_tmp.GlyphsHighest = ImMax(dst_tmp.GlyphsHighest, src_tmp.GlyphsHighest); + } + + // 2. For every requested codepoint, check for their presence in the font data, and handle redundancy or overlaps between source fonts to avoid unused glyphs. + int total_glyphs_count = 0; + for (int src_i = 0; src_i < src_tmp_array.Size; src_i++) + { + ImFontBuildSrcData& src_tmp = src_tmp_array[src_i]; + ImFontBuildDstData& dst_tmp = dst_tmp_array[src_tmp.DstIndex]; + src_tmp.GlyphsSet.Create(src_tmp.GlyphsHighest + 1); + if (dst_tmp.GlyphsSet.Storage.empty()) + dst_tmp.GlyphsSet.Create(dst_tmp.GlyphsHighest + 1); + + for (const ImWchar* src_range = src_tmp.SrcRanges; src_range[0] && src_range[1]; src_range += 2) + for (unsigned int codepoint = src_range[0]; codepoint <= src_range[1]; codepoint++) + { + if (dst_tmp.GlyphsSet.TestBit(codepoint)) // Don't overwrite existing glyphs. We could make this an option for MergeMode (e.g. MergeOverwrite==true) + continue; + if (!stbtt_FindGlyphIndex(&src_tmp.FontInfo, codepoint)) // It is actually in the font? + continue; + + // Add to avail set/counters + src_tmp.GlyphsCount++; + dst_tmp.GlyphsCount++; + src_tmp.GlyphsSet.SetBit(codepoint); + dst_tmp.GlyphsSet.SetBit(codepoint); + total_glyphs_count++; + } + } + + // 3. Unpack our bit map into a flat list (we now have all the Unicode points that we know are requested _and_ available _and_ not overlapping another) + for (int src_i = 0; src_i < src_tmp_array.Size; src_i++) + { + ImFontBuildSrcData& src_tmp = src_tmp_array[src_i]; + src_tmp.GlyphsList.reserve(src_tmp.GlyphsCount); + UnpackBitVectorToFlatIndexList(&src_tmp.GlyphsSet, &src_tmp.GlyphsList); + src_tmp.GlyphsSet.Clear(); + IM_ASSERT(src_tmp.GlyphsList.Size == src_tmp.GlyphsCount); + } + for (int dst_i = 0; dst_i < dst_tmp_array.Size; dst_i++) + dst_tmp_array[dst_i].GlyphsSet.Clear(); + dst_tmp_array.clear(); + + // Allocate packing character data and flag packed characters buffer as non-packed (x0=y0=x1=y1=0) + // (We technically don't need to zero-clear buf_rects, but let's do it for the sake of sanity) + ImVector buf_rects; + ImVector buf_packedchars; + buf_rects.resize(total_glyphs_count); + buf_packedchars.resize(total_glyphs_count); + memset(buf_rects.Data, 0, (size_t)buf_rects.size_in_bytes()); + memset(buf_packedchars.Data, 0, (size_t)buf_packedchars.size_in_bytes()); + + // 4. Gather glyphs sizes so we can pack them in our virtual canvas. + int total_surface = 0; + int buf_rects_out_n = 0; + int buf_packedchars_out_n = 0; + for (int src_i = 0; src_i < src_tmp_array.Size; src_i++) + { + ImFontBuildSrcData& src_tmp = src_tmp_array[src_i]; + if (src_tmp.GlyphsCount == 0) + continue; + + src_tmp.Rects = &buf_rects[buf_rects_out_n]; + src_tmp.PackedChars = &buf_packedchars[buf_packedchars_out_n]; + buf_rects_out_n += src_tmp.GlyphsCount; + buf_packedchars_out_n += src_tmp.GlyphsCount; + + // Convert our ranges in the format stb_truetype wants + ImFontConfig& cfg = atlas->ConfigData[src_i]; + src_tmp.PackRange.font_size = cfg.SizePixels; + src_tmp.PackRange.first_unicode_codepoint_in_range = 0; + src_tmp.PackRange.array_of_unicode_codepoints = src_tmp.GlyphsList.Data; + src_tmp.PackRange.num_chars = src_tmp.GlyphsList.Size; + src_tmp.PackRange.chardata_for_range = src_tmp.PackedChars; + src_tmp.PackRange.h_oversample = (unsigned char)cfg.OversampleH; + src_tmp.PackRange.v_oversample = (unsigned char)cfg.OversampleV; + + // Gather the sizes of all rectangles we will need to pack (this loop is based on stbtt_PackFontRangesGatherRects) + const float scale = (cfg.SizePixels > 0) ? stbtt_ScaleForPixelHeight(&src_tmp.FontInfo, cfg.SizePixels) : stbtt_ScaleForMappingEmToPixels(&src_tmp.FontInfo, -cfg.SizePixels); + const int padding = atlas->TexGlyphPadding; + for (int glyph_i = 0; glyph_i < src_tmp.GlyphsList.Size; glyph_i++) + { + int x0, y0, x1, y1; + const int glyph_index_in_font = stbtt_FindGlyphIndex(&src_tmp.FontInfo, src_tmp.GlyphsList[glyph_i]); + IM_ASSERT(glyph_index_in_font != 0); + stbtt_GetGlyphBitmapBoxSubpixel(&src_tmp.FontInfo, glyph_index_in_font, scale * cfg.OversampleH, scale * cfg.OversampleV, 0, 0, &x0, &y0, &x1, &y1); + src_tmp.Rects[glyph_i].w = (stbrp_coord)(x1 - x0 + padding + cfg.OversampleH - 1); + src_tmp.Rects[glyph_i].h = (stbrp_coord)(y1 - y0 + padding + cfg.OversampleV - 1); + total_surface += src_tmp.Rects[glyph_i].w * src_tmp.Rects[glyph_i].h; + } + } + + // We need a width for the skyline algorithm, any width! + // The exact width doesn't really matter much, but some API/GPU have texture size limitations and increasing width can decrease height. + // User can override TexDesiredWidth and TexGlyphPadding if they wish, otherwise we use a simple heuristic to select the width based on expected surface. + const int surface_sqrt = (int)ImSqrt((float)total_surface) + 1; + atlas->TexHeight = 0; + if (atlas->TexDesiredWidth > 0) + atlas->TexWidth = atlas->TexDesiredWidth; + else + atlas->TexWidth = (surface_sqrt >= 4096 * 0.7f) ? 4096 : (surface_sqrt >= 2048 * 0.7f) ? 2048 : (surface_sqrt >= 1024 * 0.7f) ? 1024 : 512; + + // 5. Start packing + // Pack our extra data rectangles first, so it will be on the upper-left corner of our texture (UV will have small values). + const int TEX_HEIGHT_MAX = 1024 * 32; + stbtt_pack_context spc = {}; + stbtt_PackBegin(&spc, NULL, atlas->TexWidth, TEX_HEIGHT_MAX, 0, atlas->TexGlyphPadding, NULL); + ImFontAtlasBuildPackCustomRects(atlas, spc.pack_info); + + // 6. Pack each source font. No rendering yet, we are working with rectangles in an infinitely tall texture at this point. + for (int src_i = 0; src_i < src_tmp_array.Size; src_i++) + { + ImFontBuildSrcData& src_tmp = src_tmp_array[src_i]; + if (src_tmp.GlyphsCount == 0) + continue; + + stbrp_pack_rects((stbrp_context*)spc.pack_info, src_tmp.Rects, src_tmp.GlyphsCount); + + // Extend texture height and mark missing glyphs as non-packed so we won't render them. + // FIXME: We are not handling packing failure here (would happen if we got off TEX_HEIGHT_MAX or if a single if larger than TexWidth?) + for (int glyph_i = 0; glyph_i < src_tmp.GlyphsCount; glyph_i++) + if (src_tmp.Rects[glyph_i].was_packed) + atlas->TexHeight = ImMax(atlas->TexHeight, src_tmp.Rects[glyph_i].y + src_tmp.Rects[glyph_i].h); + } + + // 7. Allocate texture + atlas->TexHeight = (atlas->Flags & ImFontAtlasFlags_NoPowerOfTwoHeight) ? (atlas->TexHeight + 1) : ImUpperPowerOfTwo(atlas->TexHeight); + atlas->TexUvScale = ImVec2(1.0f / atlas->TexWidth, 1.0f / atlas->TexHeight); + atlas->TexPixelsAlpha8 = (unsigned char*)IM_ALLOC(atlas->TexWidth * atlas->TexHeight); + memset(atlas->TexPixelsAlpha8, 0, atlas->TexWidth * atlas->TexHeight); + spc.pixels = atlas->TexPixelsAlpha8; + spc.height = atlas->TexHeight; + + // 8. Render/rasterize font characters into the texture + for (int src_i = 0; src_i < src_tmp_array.Size; src_i++) + { + ImFontConfig& cfg = atlas->ConfigData[src_i]; + ImFontBuildSrcData& src_tmp = src_tmp_array[src_i]; + if (src_tmp.GlyphsCount == 0) + continue; + + stbtt_PackFontRangesRenderIntoRects(&spc, &src_tmp.FontInfo, &src_tmp.PackRange, 1, src_tmp.Rects); + + // Apply multiply operator + if (cfg.RasterizerMultiply != 1.0f) + { + unsigned char multiply_table[256]; + ImFontAtlasBuildMultiplyCalcLookupTable(multiply_table, cfg.RasterizerMultiply); + stbrp_rect* r = &src_tmp.Rects[0]; + for (int glyph_i = 0; glyph_i < src_tmp.GlyphsCount; glyph_i++, r++) + if (r->was_packed) + ImFontAtlasBuildMultiplyRectAlpha8(multiply_table, atlas->TexPixelsAlpha8, r->x, r->y, r->w, r->h, atlas->TexWidth * 1); + } + src_tmp.Rects = NULL; + } + + // End packing + stbtt_PackEnd(&spc); + buf_rects.clear(); + + // 9. Setup ImFont and glyphs for runtime + for (int src_i = 0; src_i < src_tmp_array.Size; src_i++) + { + ImFontBuildSrcData& src_tmp = src_tmp_array[src_i]; + if (src_tmp.GlyphsCount == 0) + continue; + + // When merging fonts with MergeMode=true: + // - We can have multiple input fonts writing into a same destination font. + // - dst_font->ConfigData is != from cfg which is our source configuration. + ImFontConfig& cfg = atlas->ConfigData[src_i]; + ImFont* dst_font = cfg.DstFont; + + const float font_scale = stbtt_ScaleForPixelHeight(&src_tmp.FontInfo, cfg.SizePixels); + int unscaled_ascent, unscaled_descent, unscaled_line_gap; + stbtt_GetFontVMetrics(&src_tmp.FontInfo, &unscaled_ascent, &unscaled_descent, &unscaled_line_gap); + + const float ascent = ImFloor(unscaled_ascent * font_scale + ((unscaled_ascent > 0.0f) ? +1 : -1)); + const float descent = ImFloor(unscaled_descent * font_scale + ((unscaled_descent > 0.0f) ? +1 : -1)); + ImFontAtlasBuildSetupFont(atlas, dst_font, &cfg, ascent, descent); + const float font_off_x = cfg.GlyphOffset.x; + const float font_off_y = cfg.GlyphOffset.y + IM_ROUND(dst_font->Ascent); + + for (int glyph_i = 0; glyph_i < src_tmp.GlyphsCount; glyph_i++) + { + // Register glyph + const int codepoint = src_tmp.GlyphsList[glyph_i]; + const stbtt_packedchar& pc = src_tmp.PackedChars[glyph_i]; + stbtt_aligned_quad q; + float unused_x = 0.0f, unused_y = 0.0f; + stbtt_GetPackedQuad(src_tmp.PackedChars, atlas->TexWidth, atlas->TexHeight, glyph_i, &unused_x, &unused_y, &q, 0); + dst_font->AddGlyph(&cfg, (ImWchar)codepoint, q.x0 + font_off_x, q.y0 + font_off_y, q.x1 + font_off_x, q.y1 + font_off_y, q.s0, q.t0, q.s1, q.t1, pc.xadvance); + } + } + + // Cleanup + src_tmp_array.clear_destruct(); + + ImFontAtlasBuildFinish(atlas); + return true; +} + +const ImFontBuilderIO* ImFontAtlasGetBuilderForStbTruetype() +{ + static ImFontBuilderIO io; + io.FontBuilder_Build = ImFontAtlasBuildWithStbTruetype; + return &io; +} + +#endif // IMGUI_ENABLE_STB_TRUETYPE + +void ImFontAtlasBuildSetupFont(ImFontAtlas* atlas, ImFont* font, ImFontConfig* font_config, float ascent, float descent) +{ + if (!font_config->MergeMode) + { + font->ClearOutputData(); + font->FontSize = font_config->SizePixels; + font->ConfigData = font_config; + font->ConfigDataCount = 0; + font->ContainerAtlas = atlas; + font->Ascent = ascent; + font->Descent = descent; + } + font->ConfigDataCount++; +} + +void ImFontAtlasBuildPackCustomRects(ImFontAtlas* atlas, void* stbrp_context_opaque) +{ + stbrp_context* pack_context = (stbrp_context*)stbrp_context_opaque; + IM_ASSERT(pack_context != NULL); + + ImVector& user_rects = atlas->CustomRects; + IM_ASSERT(user_rects.Size >= 1); // We expect at least the default custom rects to be registered, else something went wrong. + + ImVector pack_rects; + pack_rects.resize(user_rects.Size); + memset(pack_rects.Data, 0, (size_t)pack_rects.size_in_bytes()); + for (int i = 0; i < user_rects.Size; i++) + { + pack_rects[i].w = user_rects[i].Width; + pack_rects[i].h = user_rects[i].Height; + } + stbrp_pack_rects(pack_context, &pack_rects[0], pack_rects.Size); + for (int i = 0; i < pack_rects.Size; i++) + if (pack_rects[i].was_packed) + { + user_rects[i].X = pack_rects[i].x; + user_rects[i].Y = pack_rects[i].y; + IM_ASSERT(pack_rects[i].w == user_rects[i].Width && pack_rects[i].h == user_rects[i].Height); + atlas->TexHeight = ImMax(atlas->TexHeight, pack_rects[i].y + pack_rects[i].h); + } +} + +void ImFontAtlasBuildRender8bppRectFromString(ImFontAtlas* atlas, int x, int y, int w, int h, const char* in_str, char in_marker_char, unsigned char in_marker_pixel_value) +{ + IM_ASSERT(x >= 0 && x + w <= atlas->TexWidth); + IM_ASSERT(y >= 0 && y + h <= atlas->TexHeight); + unsigned char* out_pixel = atlas->TexPixelsAlpha8 + x + (y * atlas->TexWidth); + for (int off_y = 0; off_y < h; off_y++, out_pixel += atlas->TexWidth, in_str += w) + for (int off_x = 0; off_x < w; off_x++) + out_pixel[off_x] = (in_str[off_x] == in_marker_char) ? in_marker_pixel_value : 0x00; +} + +void ImFontAtlasBuildRender32bppRectFromString(ImFontAtlas* atlas, int x, int y, int w, int h, const char* in_str, char in_marker_char, unsigned int in_marker_pixel_value) +{ + IM_ASSERT(x >= 0 && x + w <= atlas->TexWidth); + IM_ASSERT(y >= 0 && y + h <= atlas->TexHeight); + unsigned int* out_pixel = atlas->TexPixelsRGBA32 + x + (y * atlas->TexWidth); + for (int off_y = 0; off_y < h; off_y++, out_pixel += atlas->TexWidth, in_str += w) + for (int off_x = 0; off_x < w; off_x++) + out_pixel[off_x] = (in_str[off_x] == in_marker_char) ? in_marker_pixel_value : IM_COL32_BLACK_TRANS; +} + +static void ImFontAtlasBuildRenderDefaultTexData(ImFontAtlas* atlas) +{ + ImFontAtlasCustomRect* r = atlas->GetCustomRectByIndex(atlas->PackIdMouseCursors); + IM_ASSERT(r->IsPacked()); + + const int w = atlas->TexWidth; + if (!(atlas->Flags & ImFontAtlasFlags_NoMouseCursors)) + { + // Render/copy pixels + IM_ASSERT(r->Width == FONT_ATLAS_DEFAULT_TEX_DATA_W * 2 + 1 && r->Height == FONT_ATLAS_DEFAULT_TEX_DATA_H); + const int x_for_white = r->X; + const int x_for_black = r->X + FONT_ATLAS_DEFAULT_TEX_DATA_W + 1; + if (atlas->TexPixelsAlpha8 != NULL) + { + ImFontAtlasBuildRender8bppRectFromString(atlas, x_for_white, r->Y, FONT_ATLAS_DEFAULT_TEX_DATA_W, FONT_ATLAS_DEFAULT_TEX_DATA_H, FONT_ATLAS_DEFAULT_TEX_DATA_PIXELS, '.', 0xFF); + ImFontAtlasBuildRender8bppRectFromString(atlas, x_for_black, r->Y, FONT_ATLAS_DEFAULT_TEX_DATA_W, FONT_ATLAS_DEFAULT_TEX_DATA_H, FONT_ATLAS_DEFAULT_TEX_DATA_PIXELS, 'X', 0xFF); + } + else + { + ImFontAtlasBuildRender32bppRectFromString(atlas, x_for_white, r->Y, FONT_ATLAS_DEFAULT_TEX_DATA_W, FONT_ATLAS_DEFAULT_TEX_DATA_H, FONT_ATLAS_DEFAULT_TEX_DATA_PIXELS, '.', IM_COL32_WHITE); + ImFontAtlasBuildRender32bppRectFromString(atlas, x_for_black, r->Y, FONT_ATLAS_DEFAULT_TEX_DATA_W, FONT_ATLAS_DEFAULT_TEX_DATA_H, FONT_ATLAS_DEFAULT_TEX_DATA_PIXELS, 'X', IM_COL32_WHITE); + } + } + else + { + // Render 4 white pixels + IM_ASSERT(r->Width == 2 && r->Height == 2); + const int offset = (int)r->X + (int)r->Y * w; + if (atlas->TexPixelsAlpha8 != NULL) + { + atlas->TexPixelsAlpha8[offset] = atlas->TexPixelsAlpha8[offset + 1] = atlas->TexPixelsAlpha8[offset + w] = atlas->TexPixelsAlpha8[offset + w + 1] = 0xFF; + } + else + { + atlas->TexPixelsRGBA32[offset] = atlas->TexPixelsRGBA32[offset + 1] = atlas->TexPixelsRGBA32[offset + w] = atlas->TexPixelsRGBA32[offset + w + 1] = IM_COL32_WHITE; + } + } + atlas->TexUvWhitePixel = ImVec2((r->X + 0.5f) * atlas->TexUvScale.x, (r->Y + 0.5f) * atlas->TexUvScale.y); +} + +static void ImFontAtlasBuildRenderLinesTexData(ImFontAtlas* atlas) +{ + if (atlas->Flags & ImFontAtlasFlags_NoBakedLines) + return; + + // This generates a triangular shape in the texture, with the various line widths stacked on top of each other to allow interpolation between them + ImFontAtlasCustomRect* r = atlas->GetCustomRectByIndex(atlas->PackIdLines); + IM_ASSERT(r->IsPacked()); + for (unsigned int n = 0; n < IM_DRAWLIST_TEX_LINES_WIDTH_MAX + 1; n++) // +1 because of the zero-width row + { + // Each line consists of at least two empty pixels at the ends, with a line of solid pixels in the middle + unsigned int y = n; + unsigned int line_width = n; + unsigned int pad_left = (r->Width - line_width) / 2; + unsigned int pad_right = r->Width - (pad_left + line_width); + + // Write each slice + IM_ASSERT(pad_left + line_width + pad_right == r->Width && y < r->Height); // Make sure we're inside the texture bounds before we start writing pixels + if (atlas->TexPixelsAlpha8 != NULL) + { + unsigned char* write_ptr = &atlas->TexPixelsAlpha8[r->X + ((r->Y + y) * atlas->TexWidth)]; + for (unsigned int i = 0; i < pad_left; i++) + *(write_ptr + i) = 0x00; + + for (unsigned int i = 0; i < line_width; i++) + *(write_ptr + pad_left + i) = 0xFF; + + for (unsigned int i = 0; i < pad_right; i++) + *(write_ptr + pad_left + line_width + i) = 0x00; + } + else + { + unsigned int* write_ptr = &atlas->TexPixelsRGBA32[r->X + ((r->Y + y) * atlas->TexWidth)]; + for (unsigned int i = 0; i < pad_left; i++) + *(write_ptr + i) = IM_COL32_BLACK_TRANS; + + for (unsigned int i = 0; i < line_width; i++) + *(write_ptr + pad_left + i) = IM_COL32_WHITE; + + for (unsigned int i = 0; i < pad_right; i++) + *(write_ptr + pad_left + line_width + i) = IM_COL32_BLACK_TRANS; + } + + // Calculate UVs for this line + ImVec2 uv0 = ImVec2((float)(r->X + pad_left - 1), (float)(r->Y + y)) * atlas->TexUvScale; + ImVec2 uv1 = ImVec2((float)(r->X + pad_left + line_width + 1), (float)(r->Y + y + 1)) * atlas->TexUvScale; + float half_v = (uv0.y + uv1.y) * 0.5f; // Calculate a constant V in the middle of the row to avoid sampling artifacts + atlas->TexUvLines[n] = ImVec4(uv0.x, half_v, uv1.x, half_v); + } +} + +// Note: this is called / shared by both the stb_truetype and the FreeType builder +void ImFontAtlasBuildInit(ImFontAtlas* atlas) +{ + // Register texture region for mouse cursors or standard white pixels + if (atlas->PackIdMouseCursors < 0) + { + if (!(atlas->Flags & ImFontAtlasFlags_NoMouseCursors)) + atlas->PackIdMouseCursors = atlas->AddCustomRectRegular(FONT_ATLAS_DEFAULT_TEX_DATA_W * 2 + 1, FONT_ATLAS_DEFAULT_TEX_DATA_H); + else + atlas->PackIdMouseCursors = atlas->AddCustomRectRegular(2, 2); + } + + // Register texture region for thick lines + // The +2 here is to give space for the end caps, whilst height +1 is to accommodate the fact we have a zero-width row + if (atlas->PackIdLines < 0) + { + if (!(atlas->Flags & ImFontAtlasFlags_NoBakedLines)) + atlas->PackIdLines = atlas->AddCustomRectRegular(IM_DRAWLIST_TEX_LINES_WIDTH_MAX + 2, IM_DRAWLIST_TEX_LINES_WIDTH_MAX + 1); + } +} + +// This is called/shared by both the stb_truetype and the FreeType builder. +void ImFontAtlasBuildFinish(ImFontAtlas* atlas) +{ + // Render into our custom data blocks + IM_ASSERT(atlas->TexPixelsAlpha8 != NULL || atlas->TexPixelsRGBA32 != NULL); + ImFontAtlasBuildRenderDefaultTexData(atlas); + ImFontAtlasBuildRenderLinesTexData(atlas); + + // Register custom rectangle glyphs + for (int i = 0; i < atlas->CustomRects.Size; i++) + { + const ImFontAtlasCustomRect* r = &atlas->CustomRects[i]; + if (r->Font == NULL || r->GlyphID == 0) + continue; + + // Will ignore ImFontConfig settings: GlyphMinAdvanceX, GlyphMinAdvanceY, GlyphExtraSpacing, PixelSnapH + IM_ASSERT(r->Font->ContainerAtlas == atlas); + ImVec2 uv0, uv1; + atlas->CalcCustomRectUV(r, &uv0, &uv1); + r->Font->AddGlyph(NULL, (ImWchar)r->GlyphID, r->GlyphOffset.x, r->GlyphOffset.y, r->GlyphOffset.x + r->Width, r->GlyphOffset.y + r->Height, uv0.x, uv0.y, uv1.x, uv1.y, r->GlyphAdvanceX); + } + + // Build all fonts lookup tables + for (int i = 0; i < atlas->Fonts.Size; i++) + if (atlas->Fonts[i]->DirtyLookupTables) + atlas->Fonts[i]->BuildLookupTable(); + + atlas->TexReady = true; +} + +// Retrieve list of range (2 int per range, values are inclusive) +const ImWchar* ImFontAtlas::GetGlyphRangesDefault() +{ + static const ImWchar ranges[] = + { + 0x0020, 0x00FF, // Basic Latin + Latin Supplement + 0, + }; + return &ranges[0]; +} + +const ImWchar* ImFontAtlas::GetGlyphRangesKorean() +{ + static const ImWchar ranges[] = + { + 0x0020, 0x00FF, // Basic Latin + Latin Supplement + 0x3131, 0x3163, // Korean alphabets + 0xAC00, 0xD7A3, // Korean characters + 0xFFFD, 0xFFFD, // Invalid + 0, + }; + return &ranges[0]; +} + +const ImWchar* ImFontAtlas::GetGlyphRangesChineseFull() +{ + static const ImWchar ranges[] = + { + 0x0020, 0x00FF, // Basic Latin + Latin Supplement + 0x2000, 0x206F, // General Punctuation + 0x3000, 0x30FF, // CJK Symbols and Punctuations, Hiragana, Katakana + 0x31F0, 0x31FF, // Katakana Phonetic Extensions + 0xFF00, 0xFFEF, // Half-width characters + 0xFFFD, 0xFFFD, // Invalid + 0x4e00, 0x9FAF, // CJK Ideograms + 0, + }; + return &ranges[0]; +} + +static void UnpackAccumulativeOffsetsIntoRanges(int base_codepoint, const short* accumulative_offsets, int accumulative_offsets_count, ImWchar* out_ranges) +{ + for (int n = 0; n < accumulative_offsets_count; n++, out_ranges += 2) + { + out_ranges[0] = out_ranges[1] = (ImWchar)(base_codepoint + accumulative_offsets[n]); + base_codepoint += accumulative_offsets[n]; + } + out_ranges[0] = 0; +} + +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] ImFontAtlas glyph ranges helpers +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +const ImWchar* ImFontAtlas::GetGlyphRangesChineseSimplifiedCommon() +{ + // Store 2500 regularly used characters for Simplified Chinese. + // Sourced from https://zh.wiktionary.org/wiki/%E9%99%84%E5%BD%95:%E7%8E%B0%E4%BB%A3%E6%B1%89%E8%AF%AD%E5%B8%B8%E7%94%A8%E5%AD%97%E8%A1%A8 + // This table covers 97.97% of all characters used during the month in July, 1987. + // You can use ImFontGlyphRangesBuilder to create your own ranges derived from this, by merging existing ranges or adding new characters. + // (Stored as accumulative offsets from the initial unicode codepoint 0x4E00. This encoding is designed to helps us compact the source code size.) + static const short accumulative_offsets_from_0x4E00[] = + { + 0,1,2,4,1,1,1,1,2,1,3,2,1,2,2,1,1,1,1,1,5,2,1,2,3,3,3,2,2,4,1,1,1,2,1,5,2,3,1,2,1,2,1,1,2,1,1,2,2,1,4,1,1,1,1,5,10,1,2,19,2,1,2,1,2,1,2,1,2, + 1,5,1,6,3,2,1,2,2,1,1,1,4,8,5,1,1,4,1,1,3,1,2,1,5,1,2,1,1,1,10,1,1,5,2,4,6,1,4,2,2,2,12,2,1,1,6,1,1,1,4,1,1,4,6,5,1,4,2,2,4,10,7,1,1,4,2,4, + 2,1,4,3,6,10,12,5,7,2,14,2,9,1,1,6,7,10,4,7,13,1,5,4,8,4,1,1,2,28,5,6,1,1,5,2,5,20,2,2,9,8,11,2,9,17,1,8,6,8,27,4,6,9,20,11,27,6,68,2,2,1,1, + 1,2,1,2,2,7,6,11,3,3,1,1,3,1,2,1,1,1,1,1,3,1,1,8,3,4,1,5,7,2,1,4,4,8,4,2,1,2,1,1,4,5,6,3,6,2,12,3,1,3,9,2,4,3,4,1,5,3,3,1,3,7,1,5,1,1,1,1,2, + 3,4,5,2,3,2,6,1,1,2,1,7,1,7,3,4,5,15,2,2,1,5,3,22,19,2,1,1,1,1,2,5,1,1,1,6,1,1,12,8,2,9,18,22,4,1,1,5,1,16,1,2,7,10,15,1,1,6,2,4,1,2,4,1,6, + 1,1,3,2,4,1,6,4,5,1,2,1,1,2,1,10,3,1,3,2,1,9,3,2,5,7,2,19,4,3,6,1,1,1,1,1,4,3,2,1,1,1,2,5,3,1,1,1,2,2,1,1,2,1,1,2,1,3,1,1,1,3,7,1,4,1,1,2,1, + 1,2,1,2,4,4,3,8,1,1,1,2,1,3,5,1,3,1,3,4,6,2,2,14,4,6,6,11,9,1,15,3,1,28,5,2,5,5,3,1,3,4,5,4,6,14,3,2,3,5,21,2,7,20,10,1,2,19,2,4,28,28,2,3, + 2,1,14,4,1,26,28,42,12,40,3,52,79,5,14,17,3,2,2,11,3,4,6,3,1,8,2,23,4,5,8,10,4,2,7,3,5,1,1,6,3,1,2,2,2,5,28,1,1,7,7,20,5,3,29,3,17,26,1,8,4, + 27,3,6,11,23,5,3,4,6,13,24,16,6,5,10,25,35,7,3,2,3,3,14,3,6,2,6,1,4,2,3,8,2,1,1,3,3,3,4,1,1,13,2,2,4,5,2,1,14,14,1,2,2,1,4,5,2,3,1,14,3,12, + 3,17,2,16,5,1,2,1,8,9,3,19,4,2,2,4,17,25,21,20,28,75,1,10,29,103,4,1,2,1,1,4,2,4,1,2,3,24,2,2,2,1,1,2,1,3,8,1,1,1,2,1,1,3,1,1,1,6,1,5,3,1,1, + 1,3,4,1,1,5,2,1,5,6,13,9,16,1,1,1,1,3,2,3,2,4,5,2,5,2,2,3,7,13,7,2,2,1,1,1,1,2,3,3,2,1,6,4,9,2,1,14,2,14,2,1,18,3,4,14,4,11,41,15,23,15,23, + 176,1,3,4,1,1,1,1,5,3,1,2,3,7,3,1,1,2,1,2,4,4,6,2,4,1,9,7,1,10,5,8,16,29,1,1,2,2,3,1,3,5,2,4,5,4,1,1,2,2,3,3,7,1,6,10,1,17,1,44,4,6,2,1,1,6, + 5,4,2,10,1,6,9,2,8,1,24,1,2,13,7,8,8,2,1,4,1,3,1,3,3,5,2,5,10,9,4,9,12,2,1,6,1,10,1,1,7,7,4,10,8,3,1,13,4,3,1,6,1,3,5,2,1,2,17,16,5,2,16,6, + 1,4,2,1,3,3,6,8,5,11,11,1,3,3,2,4,6,10,9,5,7,4,7,4,7,1,1,4,2,1,3,6,8,7,1,6,11,5,5,3,24,9,4,2,7,13,5,1,8,82,16,61,1,1,1,4,2,2,16,10,3,8,1,1, + 6,4,2,1,3,1,1,1,4,3,8,4,2,2,1,1,1,1,1,6,3,5,1,1,4,6,9,2,1,1,1,2,1,7,2,1,6,1,5,4,4,3,1,8,1,3,3,1,3,2,2,2,2,3,1,6,1,2,1,2,1,3,7,1,8,2,1,2,1,5, + 2,5,3,5,10,1,2,1,1,3,2,5,11,3,9,3,5,1,1,5,9,1,2,1,5,7,9,9,8,1,3,3,3,6,8,2,3,2,1,1,32,6,1,2,15,9,3,7,13,1,3,10,13,2,14,1,13,10,2,1,3,10,4,15, + 2,15,15,10,1,3,9,6,9,32,25,26,47,7,3,2,3,1,6,3,4,3,2,8,5,4,1,9,4,2,2,19,10,6,2,3,8,1,2,2,4,2,1,9,4,4,4,6,4,8,9,2,3,1,1,1,1,3,5,5,1,3,8,4,6, + 2,1,4,12,1,5,3,7,13,2,5,8,1,6,1,2,5,14,6,1,5,2,4,8,15,5,1,23,6,62,2,10,1,1,8,1,2,2,10,4,2,2,9,2,1,1,3,2,3,1,5,3,3,2,1,3,8,1,1,1,11,3,1,1,4, + 3,7,1,14,1,2,3,12,5,2,5,1,6,7,5,7,14,11,1,3,1,8,9,12,2,1,11,8,4,4,2,6,10,9,13,1,1,3,1,5,1,3,2,4,4,1,18,2,3,14,11,4,29,4,2,7,1,3,13,9,2,2,5, + 3,5,20,7,16,8,5,72,34,6,4,22,12,12,28,45,36,9,7,39,9,191,1,1,1,4,11,8,4,9,2,3,22,1,1,1,1,4,17,1,7,7,1,11,31,10,2,4,8,2,3,2,1,4,2,16,4,32,2, + 3,19,13,4,9,1,5,2,14,8,1,1,3,6,19,6,5,1,16,6,2,10,8,5,1,2,3,1,5,5,1,11,6,6,1,3,3,2,6,3,8,1,1,4,10,7,5,7,7,5,8,9,2,1,3,4,1,1,3,1,3,3,2,6,16, + 1,4,6,3,1,10,6,1,3,15,2,9,2,10,25,13,9,16,6,2,2,10,11,4,3,9,1,2,6,6,5,4,30,40,1,10,7,12,14,33,6,3,6,7,3,1,3,1,11,14,4,9,5,12,11,49,18,51,31, + 140,31,2,2,1,5,1,8,1,10,1,4,4,3,24,1,10,1,3,6,6,16,3,4,5,2,1,4,2,57,10,6,22,2,22,3,7,22,6,10,11,36,18,16,33,36,2,5,5,1,1,1,4,10,1,4,13,2,7, + 5,2,9,3,4,1,7,43,3,7,3,9,14,7,9,1,11,1,1,3,7,4,18,13,1,14,1,3,6,10,73,2,2,30,6,1,11,18,19,13,22,3,46,42,37,89,7,3,16,34,2,2,3,9,1,7,1,1,1,2, + 2,4,10,7,3,10,3,9,5,28,9,2,6,13,7,3,1,3,10,2,7,2,11,3,6,21,54,85,2,1,4,2,2,1,39,3,21,2,2,5,1,1,1,4,1,1,3,4,15,1,3,2,4,4,2,3,8,2,20,1,8,7,13, + 4,1,26,6,2,9,34,4,21,52,10,4,4,1,5,12,2,11,1,7,2,30,12,44,2,30,1,1,3,6,16,9,17,39,82,2,2,24,7,1,7,3,16,9,14,44,2,1,2,1,2,3,5,2,4,1,6,7,5,3, + 2,6,1,11,5,11,2,1,18,19,8,1,3,24,29,2,1,3,5,2,2,1,13,6,5,1,46,11,3,5,1,1,5,8,2,10,6,12,6,3,7,11,2,4,16,13,2,5,1,1,2,2,5,2,28,5,2,23,10,8,4, + 4,22,39,95,38,8,14,9,5,1,13,5,4,3,13,12,11,1,9,1,27,37,2,5,4,4,63,211,95,2,2,2,1,3,5,2,1,1,2,2,1,1,1,3,2,4,1,2,1,1,5,2,2,1,1,2,3,1,3,1,1,1, + 3,1,4,2,1,3,6,1,1,3,7,15,5,3,2,5,3,9,11,4,2,22,1,6,3,8,7,1,4,28,4,16,3,3,25,4,4,27,27,1,4,1,2,2,7,1,3,5,2,28,8,2,14,1,8,6,16,25,3,3,3,14,3, + 3,1,1,2,1,4,6,3,8,4,1,1,1,2,3,6,10,6,2,3,18,3,2,5,5,4,3,1,5,2,5,4,23,7,6,12,6,4,17,11,9,5,1,1,10,5,12,1,1,11,26,33,7,3,6,1,17,7,1,5,12,1,11, + 2,4,1,8,14,17,23,1,2,1,7,8,16,11,9,6,5,2,6,4,16,2,8,14,1,11,8,9,1,1,1,9,25,4,11,19,7,2,15,2,12,8,52,7,5,19,2,16,4,36,8,1,16,8,24,26,4,6,2,9, + 5,4,36,3,28,12,25,15,37,27,17,12,59,38,5,32,127,1,2,9,17,14,4,1,2,1,1,8,11,50,4,14,2,19,16,4,17,5,4,5,26,12,45,2,23,45,104,30,12,8,3,10,2,2, + 3,3,1,4,20,7,2,9,6,15,2,20,1,3,16,4,11,15,6,134,2,5,59,1,2,2,2,1,9,17,3,26,137,10,211,59,1,2,4,1,4,1,1,1,2,6,2,3,1,1,2,3,2,3,1,3,4,4,2,3,3, + 1,4,3,1,7,2,2,3,1,2,1,3,3,3,2,2,3,2,1,3,14,6,1,3,2,9,6,15,27,9,34,145,1,1,2,1,1,1,1,2,1,1,1,1,2,2,2,3,1,2,1,1,1,2,3,5,8,3,5,2,4,1,3,2,2,2,12, + 4,1,1,1,10,4,5,1,20,4,16,1,15,9,5,12,2,9,2,5,4,2,26,19,7,1,26,4,30,12,15,42,1,6,8,172,1,1,4,2,1,1,11,2,2,4,2,1,2,1,10,8,1,2,1,4,5,1,2,5,1,8, + 4,1,3,4,2,1,6,2,1,3,4,1,2,1,1,1,1,12,5,7,2,4,3,1,1,1,3,3,6,1,2,2,3,3,3,2,1,2,12,14,11,6,6,4,12,2,8,1,7,10,1,35,7,4,13,15,4,3,23,21,28,52,5, + 26,5,6,1,7,10,2,7,53,3,2,1,1,1,2,163,532,1,10,11,1,3,3,4,8,2,8,6,2,2,23,22,4,2,2,4,2,1,3,1,3,3,5,9,8,2,1,2,8,1,10,2,12,21,20,15,105,2,3,1,1, + 3,2,3,1,1,2,5,1,4,15,11,19,1,1,1,1,5,4,5,1,1,2,5,3,5,12,1,2,5,1,11,1,1,15,9,1,4,5,3,26,8,2,1,3,1,1,15,19,2,12,1,2,5,2,7,2,19,2,20,6,26,7,5, + 2,2,7,34,21,13,70,2,128,1,1,2,1,1,2,1,1,3,2,2,2,15,1,4,1,3,4,42,10,6,1,49,85,8,1,2,1,1,4,4,2,3,6,1,5,7,4,3,211,4,1,2,1,2,5,1,2,4,2,2,6,5,6, + 10,3,4,48,100,6,2,16,296,5,27,387,2,2,3,7,16,8,5,38,15,39,21,9,10,3,7,59,13,27,21,47,5,21,6 + }; + static ImWchar base_ranges[] = // not zero-terminated + { + 0x0020, 0x00FF, // Basic Latin + Latin Supplement + 0x2000, 0x206F, // General Punctuation + 0x3000, 0x30FF, // CJK Symbols and Punctuations, Hiragana, Katakana + 0x31F0, 0x31FF, // Katakana Phonetic Extensions + 0xFF00, 0xFFEF, // Half-width characters + 0xFFFD, 0xFFFD // Invalid + }; + static ImWchar full_ranges[IM_ARRAYSIZE(base_ranges) + IM_ARRAYSIZE(accumulative_offsets_from_0x4E00) * 2 + 1] = { 0 }; + if (!full_ranges[0]) + { + memcpy(full_ranges, base_ranges, sizeof(base_ranges)); + UnpackAccumulativeOffsetsIntoRanges(0x4E00, accumulative_offsets_from_0x4E00, IM_ARRAYSIZE(accumulative_offsets_from_0x4E00), full_ranges + IM_ARRAYSIZE(base_ranges)); + } + return &full_ranges[0]; +} + +const ImWchar* ImFontAtlas::GetGlyphRangesJapanese() +{ + // 2999 ideograms code points for Japanese + // - 2136 Joyo (meaning "for regular use" or "for common use") Kanji code points + // - 863 Jinmeiyo (meaning "for personal name") Kanji code points + // - Sourced from the character information database of the Information-technology Promotion Agency, Japan + // - https://mojikiban.ipa.go.jp/mji/ + // - Available under the terms of the Creative Commons Attribution-ShareAlike 2.1 Japan (CC BY-SA 2.1 JP). + // - https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-sa/2.1/jp/deed.en + // - https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-sa/2.1/jp/legalcode + // - You can generate this code by the script at: + // - https://github.com/vaiorabbit/everyday_use_kanji + // - References: + // - List of Joyo Kanji + // - (Official list by the Agency for Cultural Affairs) https://www.bunka.go.jp/kokugo_nihongo/sisaku/joho/joho/kakuki/14/tosin02/index.html + // - (Wikipedia) https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/List_of_j%C5%8Dy%C5%8D_kanji + // - List of Jinmeiyo Kanji + // - (Official list by the Ministry of Justice) http://www.moj.go.jp/MINJI/minji86.html + // - (Wikipedia) https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Jinmeiy%C5%8D_kanji + // - Missing 1 Joyo Kanji: U+20B9F (Kun'yomi: Shikaru, On'yomi: Shitsu,shichi), see https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/pull/3627 for details. + // You can use ImFontGlyphRangesBuilder to create your own ranges derived from this, by merging existing ranges or adding new characters. + // (Stored as accumulative offsets from the initial unicode codepoint 0x4E00. This encoding is designed to helps us compact the source code size.) + static const short accumulative_offsets_from_0x4E00[] = + { + 0,1,2,4,1,1,1,1,2,1,3,3,2,2,1,5,3,5,7,5,6,1,2,1,7,2,6,3,1,8,1,1,4,1,1,18,2,11,2,6,2,1,2,1,5,1,2,1,3,1,2,1,2,3,3,1,1,2,3,1,1,1,12,7,9,1,4,5,1, + 1,2,1,10,1,1,9,2,2,4,5,6,9,3,1,1,1,1,9,3,18,5,2,2,2,2,1,6,3,7,1,1,1,1,2,2,4,2,1,23,2,10,4,3,5,2,4,10,2,4,13,1,6,1,9,3,1,1,6,6,7,6,3,1,2,11,3, + 2,2,3,2,15,2,2,5,4,3,6,4,1,2,5,2,12,16,6,13,9,13,2,1,1,7,16,4,7,1,19,1,5,1,2,2,7,7,8,2,6,5,4,9,18,7,4,5,9,13,11,8,15,2,1,1,1,2,1,2,2,1,2,2,8, + 2,9,3,3,1,1,4,4,1,1,1,4,9,1,4,3,5,5,2,7,5,3,4,8,2,1,13,2,3,3,1,14,1,1,4,5,1,3,6,1,5,2,1,1,3,3,3,3,1,1,2,7,6,6,7,1,4,7,6,1,1,1,1,1,12,3,3,9,5, + 2,6,1,5,6,1,2,3,18,2,4,14,4,1,3,6,1,1,6,3,5,5,3,2,2,2,2,12,3,1,4,2,3,2,3,11,1,7,4,1,2,1,3,17,1,9,1,24,1,1,4,2,2,4,1,2,7,1,1,1,3,1,2,2,4,15,1, + 1,2,1,1,2,1,5,2,5,20,2,5,9,1,10,8,7,6,1,1,1,1,1,1,6,2,1,2,8,1,1,1,1,5,1,1,3,1,1,1,1,3,1,1,12,4,1,3,1,1,1,1,1,10,3,1,7,5,13,1,2,3,4,6,1,1,30, + 2,9,9,1,15,38,11,3,1,8,24,7,1,9,8,10,2,1,9,31,2,13,6,2,9,4,49,5,2,15,2,1,10,2,1,1,1,2,2,6,15,30,35,3,14,18,8,1,16,10,28,12,19,45,38,1,3,2,3, + 13,2,1,7,3,6,5,3,4,3,1,5,7,8,1,5,3,18,5,3,6,1,21,4,24,9,24,40,3,14,3,21,3,2,1,2,4,2,3,1,15,15,6,5,1,1,3,1,5,6,1,9,7,3,3,2,1,4,3,8,21,5,16,4, + 5,2,10,11,11,3,6,3,2,9,3,6,13,1,2,1,1,1,1,11,12,6,6,1,4,2,6,5,2,1,1,3,3,6,13,3,1,1,5,1,2,3,3,14,2,1,2,2,2,5,1,9,5,1,1,6,12,3,12,3,4,13,2,14, + 2,8,1,17,5,1,16,4,2,2,21,8,9,6,23,20,12,25,19,9,38,8,3,21,40,25,33,13,4,3,1,4,1,2,4,1,2,5,26,2,1,1,2,1,3,6,2,1,1,1,1,1,1,2,3,1,1,1,9,2,3,1,1, + 1,3,6,3,2,1,1,6,6,1,8,2,2,2,1,4,1,2,3,2,7,3,2,4,1,2,1,2,2,1,1,1,1,1,3,1,2,5,4,10,9,4,9,1,1,1,1,1,1,5,3,2,1,6,4,9,6,1,10,2,31,17,8,3,7,5,40,1, + 7,7,1,6,5,2,10,7,8,4,15,39,25,6,28,47,18,10,7,1,3,1,1,2,1,1,1,3,3,3,1,1,1,3,4,2,1,4,1,3,6,10,7,8,6,2,2,1,3,3,2,5,8,7,9,12,2,15,1,1,4,1,2,1,1, + 1,3,2,1,3,3,5,6,2,3,2,10,1,4,2,8,1,1,1,11,6,1,21,4,16,3,1,3,1,4,2,3,6,5,1,3,1,1,3,3,4,6,1,1,10,4,2,7,10,4,7,4,2,9,4,3,1,1,1,4,1,8,3,4,1,3,1, + 6,1,4,2,1,4,7,2,1,8,1,4,5,1,1,2,2,4,6,2,7,1,10,1,1,3,4,11,10,8,21,4,6,1,3,5,2,1,2,28,5,5,2,3,13,1,2,3,1,4,2,1,5,20,3,8,11,1,3,3,3,1,8,10,9,2, + 10,9,2,3,1,1,2,4,1,8,3,6,1,7,8,6,11,1,4,29,8,4,3,1,2,7,13,1,4,1,6,2,6,12,12,2,20,3,2,3,6,4,8,9,2,7,34,5,1,18,6,1,1,4,4,5,7,9,1,2,2,4,3,4,1,7, + 2,2,2,6,2,3,25,5,3,6,1,4,6,7,4,2,1,4,2,13,6,4,4,3,1,5,3,4,4,3,2,1,1,4,1,2,1,1,3,1,11,1,6,3,1,7,3,6,2,8,8,6,9,3,4,11,3,2,10,12,2,5,11,1,6,4,5, + 3,1,8,5,4,6,6,3,5,1,1,3,2,1,2,2,6,17,12,1,10,1,6,12,1,6,6,19,9,6,16,1,13,4,4,15,7,17,6,11,9,15,12,6,7,2,1,2,2,15,9,3,21,4,6,49,18,7,3,2,3,1, + 6,8,2,2,6,2,9,1,3,6,4,4,1,2,16,2,5,2,1,6,2,3,5,3,1,2,5,1,2,1,9,3,1,8,6,4,8,11,3,1,1,1,1,3,1,13,8,4,1,3,2,2,1,4,1,11,1,5,2,1,5,2,5,8,6,1,1,7, + 4,3,8,3,2,7,2,1,5,1,5,2,4,7,6,2,8,5,1,11,4,5,3,6,18,1,2,13,3,3,1,21,1,1,4,1,4,1,1,1,8,1,2,2,7,1,2,4,2,2,9,2,1,1,1,4,3,6,3,12,5,1,1,1,5,6,3,2, + 4,8,2,2,4,2,7,1,8,9,5,2,3,2,1,3,2,13,7,14,6,5,1,1,2,1,4,2,23,2,1,1,6,3,1,4,1,15,3,1,7,3,9,14,1,3,1,4,1,1,5,8,1,3,8,3,8,15,11,4,14,4,4,2,5,5, + 1,7,1,6,14,7,7,8,5,15,4,8,6,5,6,2,1,13,1,20,15,11,9,2,5,6,2,11,2,6,2,5,1,5,8,4,13,19,25,4,1,1,11,1,34,2,5,9,14,6,2,2,6,1,1,14,1,3,14,13,1,6, + 12,21,14,14,6,32,17,8,32,9,28,1,2,4,11,8,3,1,14,2,5,15,1,1,1,1,3,6,4,1,3,4,11,3,1,1,11,30,1,5,1,4,1,5,8,1,1,3,2,4,3,17,35,2,6,12,17,3,1,6,2, + 1,1,12,2,7,3,3,2,1,16,2,8,3,6,5,4,7,3,3,8,1,9,8,5,1,2,1,3,2,8,1,2,9,12,1,1,2,3,8,3,24,12,4,3,7,5,8,3,3,3,3,3,3,1,23,10,3,1,2,2,6,3,1,16,1,16, + 22,3,10,4,11,6,9,7,7,3,6,2,2,2,4,10,2,1,1,2,8,7,1,6,4,1,3,3,3,5,10,12,12,2,3,12,8,15,1,1,16,6,6,1,5,9,11,4,11,4,2,6,12,1,17,5,13,1,4,9,5,1,11, + 2,1,8,1,5,7,28,8,3,5,10,2,17,3,38,22,1,2,18,12,10,4,38,18,1,4,44,19,4,1,8,4,1,12,1,4,31,12,1,14,7,75,7,5,10,6,6,13,3,2,11,11,3,2,5,28,15,6,18, + 18,5,6,4,3,16,1,7,18,7,36,3,5,3,1,7,1,9,1,10,7,2,4,2,6,2,9,7,4,3,32,12,3,7,10,2,23,16,3,1,12,3,31,4,11,1,3,8,9,5,1,30,15,6,12,3,2,2,11,19,9, + 14,2,6,2,3,19,13,17,5,3,3,25,3,14,1,1,1,36,1,3,2,19,3,13,36,9,13,31,6,4,16,34,2,5,4,2,3,3,5,1,1,1,4,3,1,17,3,2,3,5,3,1,3,2,3,5,6,3,12,11,1,3, + 1,2,26,7,12,7,2,14,3,3,7,7,11,25,25,28,16,4,36,1,2,1,6,2,1,9,3,27,17,4,3,4,13,4,1,3,2,2,1,10,4,2,4,6,3,8,2,1,18,1,1,24,2,2,4,33,2,3,63,7,1,6, + 40,7,3,4,4,2,4,15,18,1,16,1,1,11,2,41,14,1,3,18,13,3,2,4,16,2,17,7,15,24,7,18,13,44,2,2,3,6,1,1,7,5,1,7,1,4,3,3,5,10,8,2,3,1,8,1,1,27,4,2,1, + 12,1,2,1,10,6,1,6,7,5,2,3,7,11,5,11,3,6,6,2,3,15,4,9,1,1,2,1,2,11,2,8,12,8,5,4,2,3,1,5,2,2,1,14,1,12,11,4,1,11,17,17,4,3,2,5,5,7,3,1,5,9,9,8, + 2,5,6,6,13,13,2,1,2,6,1,2,2,49,4,9,1,2,10,16,7,8,4,3,2,23,4,58,3,29,1,14,19,19,11,11,2,7,5,1,3,4,6,2,18,5,12,12,17,17,3,3,2,4,1,6,2,3,4,3,1, + 1,1,1,5,1,1,9,1,3,1,3,6,1,8,1,1,2,6,4,14,3,1,4,11,4,1,3,32,1,2,4,13,4,1,2,4,2,1,3,1,11,1,4,2,1,4,4,6,3,5,1,6,5,7,6,3,23,3,5,3,5,3,3,13,3,9,10, + 1,12,10,2,3,18,13,7,160,52,4,2,2,3,2,14,5,4,12,4,6,4,1,20,4,11,6,2,12,27,1,4,1,2,2,7,4,5,2,28,3,7,25,8,3,19,3,6,10,2,2,1,10,2,5,4,1,3,4,1,5, + 3,2,6,9,3,6,2,16,3,3,16,4,5,5,3,2,1,2,16,15,8,2,6,21,2,4,1,22,5,8,1,1,21,11,2,1,11,11,19,13,12,4,2,3,2,3,6,1,8,11,1,4,2,9,5,2,1,11,2,9,1,1,2, + 14,31,9,3,4,21,14,4,8,1,7,2,2,2,5,1,4,20,3,3,4,10,1,11,9,8,2,1,4,5,14,12,14,2,17,9,6,31,4,14,1,20,13,26,5,2,7,3,6,13,2,4,2,19,6,2,2,18,9,3,5, + 12,12,14,4,6,2,3,6,9,5,22,4,5,25,6,4,8,5,2,6,27,2,35,2,16,3,7,8,8,6,6,5,9,17,2,20,6,19,2,13,3,1,1,1,4,17,12,2,14,7,1,4,18,12,38,33,2,10,1,1, + 2,13,14,17,11,50,6,33,20,26,74,16,23,45,50,13,38,33,6,6,7,4,4,2,1,3,2,5,8,7,8,9,3,11,21,9,13,1,3,10,6,7,1,2,2,18,5,5,1,9,9,2,68,9,19,13,2,5, + 1,4,4,7,4,13,3,9,10,21,17,3,26,2,1,5,2,4,5,4,1,7,4,7,3,4,2,1,6,1,1,20,4,1,9,2,2,1,3,3,2,3,2,1,1,1,20,2,3,1,6,2,3,6,2,4,8,1,3,2,10,3,5,3,4,4, + 3,4,16,1,6,1,10,2,4,2,1,1,2,10,11,2,2,3,1,24,31,4,10,10,2,5,12,16,164,15,4,16,7,9,15,19,17,1,2,1,1,5,1,1,1,1,1,3,1,4,3,1,3,1,3,1,2,1,1,3,3,7, + 2,8,1,2,2,2,1,3,4,3,7,8,12,92,2,10,3,1,3,14,5,25,16,42,4,7,7,4,2,21,5,27,26,27,21,25,30,31,2,1,5,13,3,22,5,6,6,11,9,12,1,5,9,7,5,5,22,60,3,5, + 13,1,1,8,1,1,3,3,2,1,9,3,3,18,4,1,2,3,7,6,3,1,2,3,9,1,3,1,3,2,1,3,1,1,1,2,1,11,3,1,6,9,1,3,2,3,1,2,1,5,1,1,4,3,4,1,2,2,4,4,1,7,2,1,2,2,3,5,13, + 18,3,4,14,9,9,4,16,3,7,5,8,2,6,48,28,3,1,1,4,2,14,8,2,9,2,1,15,2,4,3,2,10,16,12,8,7,1,1,3,1,1,1,2,7,4,1,6,4,38,39,16,23,7,15,15,3,2,12,7,21, + 37,27,6,5,4,8,2,10,8,8,6,5,1,2,1,3,24,1,16,17,9,23,10,17,6,1,51,55,44,13,294,9,3,6,2,4,2,2,15,1,1,1,13,21,17,68,14,8,9,4,1,4,9,3,11,7,1,1,1, + 5,6,3,2,1,1,1,2,3,8,1,2,2,4,1,5,5,2,1,4,3,7,13,4,1,4,1,3,1,1,1,5,5,10,1,6,1,5,2,1,5,2,4,1,4,5,7,3,18,2,9,11,32,4,3,3,2,4,7,11,16,9,11,8,13,38, + 32,8,4,2,1,1,2,1,2,4,4,1,1,1,4,1,21,3,11,1,16,1,1,6,1,3,2,4,9,8,57,7,44,1,3,3,13,3,10,1,1,7,5,2,7,21,47,63,3,15,4,7,1,16,1,1,2,8,2,3,42,15,4, + 1,29,7,22,10,3,78,16,12,20,18,4,67,11,5,1,3,15,6,21,31,32,27,18,13,71,35,5,142,4,10,1,2,50,19,33,16,35,37,16,19,27,7,1,133,19,1,4,8,7,20,1,4, + 4,1,10,3,1,6,1,2,51,5,40,15,24,43,22928,11,1,13,154,70,3,1,1,7,4,10,1,2,1,1,2,1,2,1,2,2,1,1,2,1,1,1,1,1,2,1,1,1,1,1,1,1,1,1,1,1,1,1,2,1,1,1, + 3,2,1,1,1,1,2,1,1, + }; + static ImWchar base_ranges[] = // not zero-terminated + { + 0x0020, 0x00FF, // Basic Latin + Latin Supplement + 0x3000, 0x30FF, // CJK Symbols and Punctuations, Hiragana, Katakana + 0x31F0, 0x31FF, // Katakana Phonetic Extensions + 0xFF00, 0xFFEF, // Half-width characters + 0xFFFD, 0xFFFD // Invalid + }; + static ImWchar full_ranges[IM_ARRAYSIZE(base_ranges) + IM_ARRAYSIZE(accumulative_offsets_from_0x4E00)*2 + 1] = { 0 }; + if (!full_ranges[0]) + { + memcpy(full_ranges, base_ranges, sizeof(base_ranges)); + UnpackAccumulativeOffsetsIntoRanges(0x4E00, accumulative_offsets_from_0x4E00, IM_ARRAYSIZE(accumulative_offsets_from_0x4E00), full_ranges + IM_ARRAYSIZE(base_ranges)); + } + return &full_ranges[0]; +} + +const ImWchar* ImFontAtlas::GetGlyphRangesCyrillic() +{ + static const ImWchar ranges[] = + { + 0x0020, 0x00FF, // Basic Latin + Latin Supplement + 0x0400, 0x052F, // Cyrillic + Cyrillic Supplement + 0x2DE0, 0x2DFF, // Cyrillic Extended-A + 0xA640, 0xA69F, // Cyrillic Extended-B + 0, + }; + return &ranges[0]; +} + +const ImWchar* ImFontAtlas::GetGlyphRangesThai() +{ + static const ImWchar ranges[] = + { + 0x0020, 0x00FF, // Basic Latin + 0x2010, 0x205E, // Punctuations + 0x0E00, 0x0E7F, // Thai + 0, + }; + return &ranges[0]; +} + +const ImWchar* ImFontAtlas::GetGlyphRangesVietnamese() +{ + static const ImWchar ranges[] = + { + 0x0020, 0x00FF, // Basic Latin + 0x0102, 0x0103, + 0x0110, 0x0111, + 0x0128, 0x0129, + 0x0168, 0x0169, + 0x01A0, 0x01A1, + 0x01AF, 0x01B0, + 0x1EA0, 0x1EF9, + 0, + }; + return &ranges[0]; +} + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] ImFontGlyphRangesBuilder +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +void ImFontGlyphRangesBuilder::AddText(const char* text, const char* text_end) +{ + while (text_end ? (text < text_end) : *text) + { + unsigned int c = 0; + int c_len = ImTextCharFromUtf8(&c, text, text_end); + text += c_len; + if (c_len == 0) + break; + AddChar((ImWchar)c); + } +} + +void ImFontGlyphRangesBuilder::AddRanges(const ImWchar* ranges) +{ + for (; ranges[0]; ranges += 2) + for (ImWchar c = ranges[0]; c <= ranges[1]; c++) + AddChar(c); +} + +void ImFontGlyphRangesBuilder::BuildRanges(ImVector* out_ranges) +{ + const int max_codepoint = IM_UNICODE_CODEPOINT_MAX; + for (int n = 0; n <= max_codepoint; n++) + if (GetBit(n)) + { + out_ranges->push_back((ImWchar)n); + while (n < max_codepoint && GetBit(n + 1)) + n++; + out_ranges->push_back((ImWchar)n); + } + out_ranges->push_back(0); +} + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] ImFont +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +ImFont::ImFont() +{ + FontSize = 0.0f; + FallbackAdvanceX = 0.0f; + FallbackChar = (ImWchar)-1; + EllipsisChar = (ImWchar)-1; + DotChar = (ImWchar)-1; + FallbackGlyph = NULL; + ContainerAtlas = NULL; + ConfigData = NULL; + ConfigDataCount = 0; + DirtyLookupTables = false; + Scale = 1.0f; + Ascent = Descent = 0.0f; + MetricsTotalSurface = 0; + memset(Used4kPagesMap, 0, sizeof(Used4kPagesMap)); +} + +ImFont::~ImFont() +{ + ClearOutputData(); +} + +void ImFont::ClearOutputData() +{ + FontSize = 0.0f; + FallbackAdvanceX = 0.0f; + Glyphs.clear(); + IndexAdvanceX.clear(); + IndexLookup.clear(); + FallbackGlyph = NULL; + ContainerAtlas = NULL; + DirtyLookupTables = true; + Ascent = Descent = 0.0f; + MetricsTotalSurface = 0; +} + +static ImWchar FindFirstExistingGlyph(ImFont* font, const ImWchar* candidate_chars, int candidate_chars_count) +{ + for (int n = 0; n < candidate_chars_count; n++) + if (font->FindGlyphNoFallback(candidate_chars[n]) != NULL) + return candidate_chars[n]; + return (ImWchar)-1; +} + +void ImFont::BuildLookupTable() +{ + int max_codepoint = 0; + for (int i = 0; i != Glyphs.Size; i++) + max_codepoint = ImMax(max_codepoint, (int)Glyphs[i].Codepoint); + + // Build lookup table + IM_ASSERT(Glyphs.Size < 0xFFFF); // -1 is reserved + IndexAdvanceX.clear(); + IndexLookup.clear(); + DirtyLookupTables = false; + memset(Used4kPagesMap, 0, sizeof(Used4kPagesMap)); + GrowIndex(max_codepoint + 1); + for (int i = 0; i < Glyphs.Size; i++) + { + int codepoint = (int)Glyphs[i].Codepoint; + IndexAdvanceX[codepoint] = Glyphs[i].AdvanceX; + IndexLookup[codepoint] = (ImWchar)i; + + // Mark 4K page as used + const int page_n = codepoint / 4096; + Used4kPagesMap[page_n >> 3] |= 1 << (page_n & 7); + } + + // Create a glyph to handle TAB + // FIXME: Needs proper TAB handling but it needs to be contextualized (or we could arbitrary say that each string starts at "column 0" ?) + if (FindGlyph((ImWchar)' ')) + { + if (Glyphs.back().Codepoint != '\t') // So we can call this function multiple times (FIXME: Flaky) + Glyphs.resize(Glyphs.Size + 1); + ImFontGlyph& tab_glyph = Glyphs.back(); + tab_glyph = *FindGlyph((ImWchar)' '); + tab_glyph.Codepoint = '\t'; + tab_glyph.AdvanceX *= IM_TABSIZE; + IndexAdvanceX[(int)tab_glyph.Codepoint] = (float)tab_glyph.AdvanceX; + IndexLookup[(int)tab_glyph.Codepoint] = (ImWchar)(Glyphs.Size - 1); + } + + // Mark special glyphs as not visible (note that AddGlyph already mark as non-visible glyphs with zero-size polygons) + SetGlyphVisible((ImWchar)' ', false); + SetGlyphVisible((ImWchar)'\t', false); + + // Ellipsis character is required for rendering elided text. We prefer using U+2026 (horizontal ellipsis). + // However some old fonts may contain ellipsis at U+0085. Here we auto-detect most suitable ellipsis character. + // FIXME: Note that 0x2026 is rarely included in our font ranges. Because of this we are more likely to use three individual dots. + const ImWchar ellipsis_chars[] = { (ImWchar)0x2026, (ImWchar)0x0085 }; + const ImWchar dots_chars[] = { (ImWchar)'.', (ImWchar)0xFF0E }; + if (EllipsisChar == (ImWchar)-1) + EllipsisChar = FindFirstExistingGlyph(this, ellipsis_chars, IM_ARRAYSIZE(ellipsis_chars)); + if (DotChar == (ImWchar)-1) + DotChar = FindFirstExistingGlyph(this, dots_chars, IM_ARRAYSIZE(dots_chars)); + + // Setup fallback character + const ImWchar fallback_chars[] = { (ImWchar)IM_UNICODE_CODEPOINT_INVALID, (ImWchar)'?', (ImWchar)' ' }; + FallbackGlyph = FindGlyphNoFallback(FallbackChar); + if (FallbackGlyph == NULL) + { + FallbackChar = FindFirstExistingGlyph(this, fallback_chars, IM_ARRAYSIZE(fallback_chars)); + FallbackGlyph = FindGlyphNoFallback(FallbackChar); + if (FallbackGlyph == NULL) + { + FallbackGlyph = &Glyphs.back(); + FallbackChar = (ImWchar)FallbackGlyph->Codepoint; + } + } + + FallbackAdvanceX = FallbackGlyph->AdvanceX; + for (int i = 0; i < max_codepoint + 1; i++) + if (IndexAdvanceX[i] < 0.0f) + IndexAdvanceX[i] = FallbackAdvanceX; +} + +// API is designed this way to avoid exposing the 4K page size +// e.g. use with IsGlyphRangeUnused(0, 255) +bool ImFont::IsGlyphRangeUnused(unsigned int c_begin, unsigned int c_last) +{ + unsigned int page_begin = (c_begin / 4096); + unsigned int page_last = (c_last / 4096); + for (unsigned int page_n = page_begin; page_n <= page_last; page_n++) + if ((page_n >> 3) < sizeof(Used4kPagesMap)) + if (Used4kPagesMap[page_n >> 3] & (1 << (page_n & 7))) + return false; + return true; +} + +void ImFont::SetGlyphVisible(ImWchar c, bool visible) +{ + if (ImFontGlyph* glyph = (ImFontGlyph*)(void*)FindGlyph((ImWchar)c)) + glyph->Visible = visible ? 1 : 0; +} + +void ImFont::GrowIndex(int new_size) +{ + IM_ASSERT(IndexAdvanceX.Size == IndexLookup.Size); + if (new_size <= IndexLookup.Size) + return; + IndexAdvanceX.resize(new_size, -1.0f); + IndexLookup.resize(new_size, (ImWchar)-1); +} + +// x0/y0/x1/y1 are offset from the character upper-left layout position, in pixels. Therefore x0/y0 are often fairly close to zero. +// Not to be mistaken with texture coordinates, which are held by u0/v0/u1/v1 in normalized format (0.0..1.0 on each texture axis). +// 'cfg' is not necessarily == 'this->ConfigData' because multiple source fonts+configs can be used to build one target font. +void ImFont::AddGlyph(const ImFontConfig* cfg, ImWchar codepoint, float x0, float y0, float x1, float y1, float u0, float v0, float u1, float v1, float advance_x) +{ + if (cfg != NULL) + { + // Clamp & recenter if needed + const float advance_x_original = advance_x; + advance_x = ImClamp(advance_x, cfg->GlyphMinAdvanceX, cfg->GlyphMaxAdvanceX); + if (advance_x != advance_x_original) + { + float char_off_x = cfg->PixelSnapH ? ImFloor((advance_x - advance_x_original) * 0.5f) : (advance_x - advance_x_original) * 0.5f; + x0 += char_off_x; + x1 += char_off_x; + } + + // Snap to pixel + if (cfg->PixelSnapH) + advance_x = IM_ROUND(advance_x); + + // Bake spacing + advance_x += cfg->GlyphExtraSpacing.x; + } + + Glyphs.resize(Glyphs.Size + 1); + ImFontGlyph& glyph = Glyphs.back(); + glyph.Codepoint = (unsigned int)codepoint; + glyph.Visible = (x0 != x1) && (y0 != y1); + glyph.Colored = false; + glyph.X0 = x0; + glyph.Y0 = y0; + glyph.X1 = x1; + glyph.Y1 = y1; + glyph.U0 = u0; + glyph.V0 = v0; + glyph.U1 = u1; + glyph.V1 = v1; + glyph.AdvanceX = advance_x; + + // Compute rough surface usage metrics (+1 to account for average padding, +0.99 to round) + // We use (U1-U0)*TexWidth instead of X1-X0 to account for oversampling. + float pad = ContainerAtlas->TexGlyphPadding + 0.99f; + DirtyLookupTables = true; + MetricsTotalSurface += (int)((glyph.U1 - glyph.U0) * ContainerAtlas->TexWidth + pad) * (int)((glyph.V1 - glyph.V0) * ContainerAtlas->TexHeight + pad); +} + +void ImFont::AddRemapChar(ImWchar dst, ImWchar src, bool overwrite_dst) +{ + IM_ASSERT(IndexLookup.Size > 0); // Currently this can only be called AFTER the font has been built, aka after calling ImFontAtlas::GetTexDataAs*() function. + unsigned int index_size = (unsigned int)IndexLookup.Size; + + if (dst < index_size && IndexLookup.Data[dst] == (ImWchar)-1 && !overwrite_dst) // 'dst' already exists + return; + if (src >= index_size && dst >= index_size) // both 'dst' and 'src' don't exist -> no-op + return; + + GrowIndex(dst + 1); + IndexLookup[dst] = (src < index_size) ? IndexLookup.Data[src] : (ImWchar)-1; + IndexAdvanceX[dst] = (src < index_size) ? IndexAdvanceX.Data[src] : 1.0f; +} + +const ImFontGlyph* ImFont::FindGlyph(ImWchar c) const +{ + if (c >= (size_t)IndexLookup.Size) + return FallbackGlyph; + const ImWchar i = IndexLookup.Data[c]; + if (i == (ImWchar)-1) + return FallbackGlyph; + return &Glyphs.Data[i]; +} + +const ImFontGlyph* ImFont::FindGlyphNoFallback(ImWchar c) const +{ + if (c >= (size_t)IndexLookup.Size) + return NULL; + const ImWchar i = IndexLookup.Data[c]; + if (i == (ImWchar)-1) + return NULL; + return &Glyphs.Data[i]; +} + +const char* ImFont::CalcWordWrapPositionA(float scale, const char* text, const char* text_end, float wrap_width) const +{ + // Simple word-wrapping for English, not full-featured. Please submit failing cases! + // FIXME: Much possible improvements (don't cut things like "word !", "word!!!" but cut within "word,,,,", more sensible support for punctuations, support for Unicode punctuations, etc.) + + // For references, possible wrap point marked with ^ + // "aaa bbb, ccc,ddd. eee fff. ggg!" + // ^ ^ ^ ^ ^__ ^ ^ + + // List of hardcoded separators: .,;!?'" + + // Skip extra blanks after a line returns (that includes not counting them in width computation) + // e.g. "Hello world" --> "Hello" "World" + + // Cut words that cannot possibly fit within one line. + // e.g.: "The tropical fish" with ~5 characters worth of width --> "The tr" "opical" "fish" + + float line_width = 0.0f; + float word_width = 0.0f; + float blank_width = 0.0f; + wrap_width /= scale; // We work with unscaled widths to avoid scaling every characters + + const char* word_end = text; + const char* prev_word_end = NULL; + bool inside_word = true; + + const char* s = text; + while (s < text_end) + { + unsigned int c = (unsigned int)*s; + const char* next_s; + if (c < 0x80) + next_s = s + 1; + else + next_s = s + ImTextCharFromUtf8(&c, s, text_end); + if (c == 0) + break; + + if (c < 32) + { + if (c == '\n') + { + line_width = word_width = blank_width = 0.0f; + inside_word = true; + s = next_s; + continue; + } + if (c == '\r') + { + s = next_s; + continue; + } + } + + const float char_width = ((int)c < IndexAdvanceX.Size ? IndexAdvanceX.Data[c] : FallbackAdvanceX); + if (ImCharIsBlankW(c)) + { + if (inside_word) + { + line_width += blank_width; + blank_width = 0.0f; + word_end = s; + } + blank_width += char_width; + inside_word = false; + } + else + { + word_width += char_width; + if (inside_word) + { + word_end = next_s; + } + else + { + prev_word_end = word_end; + line_width += word_width + blank_width; + word_width = blank_width = 0.0f; + } + + // Allow wrapping after punctuation. + inside_word = (c != '.' && c != ',' && c != ';' && c != '!' && c != '?' && c != '\"'); + } + + // We ignore blank width at the end of the line (they can be skipped) + if (line_width + word_width > wrap_width) + { + // Words that cannot possibly fit within an entire line will be cut anywhere. + if (word_width < wrap_width) + s = prev_word_end ? prev_word_end : word_end; + break; + } + + s = next_s; + } + + return s; +} + +ImVec2 ImFont::CalcTextSizeA(float size, float max_width, float wrap_width, const char* text_begin, const char* text_end, const char** remaining) const +{ + if (!text_end) + text_end = text_begin + strlen(text_begin); // FIXME-OPT: Need to avoid this. + + const float line_height = size; + const float scale = size / FontSize; + + ImVec2 text_size = ImVec2(0, 0); + float line_width = 0.0f; + + const bool word_wrap_enabled = (wrap_width > 0.0f); + const char* word_wrap_eol = NULL; + + const char* s = text_begin; + while (s < text_end) + { + if (word_wrap_enabled) + { + // Calculate how far we can render. Requires two passes on the string data but keeps the code simple and not intrusive for what's essentially an uncommon feature. + if (!word_wrap_eol) + { + word_wrap_eol = CalcWordWrapPositionA(scale, s, text_end, wrap_width - line_width); + if (word_wrap_eol == s) // Wrap_width is too small to fit anything. Force displaying 1 character to minimize the height discontinuity. + word_wrap_eol++; // +1 may not be a character start point in UTF-8 but it's ok because we use s >= word_wrap_eol below + } + + if (s >= word_wrap_eol) + { + if (text_size.x < line_width) + text_size.x = line_width; + text_size.y += line_height; + line_width = 0.0f; + word_wrap_eol = NULL; + + // Wrapping skips upcoming blanks + while (s < text_end) + { + const char c = *s; + if (ImCharIsBlankA(c)) { s++; } else if (c == '\n') { s++; break; } else { break; } + } + continue; + } + } + + // Decode and advance source + const char* prev_s = s; + unsigned int c = (unsigned int)*s; + if (c < 0x80) + { + s += 1; + } + else + { + s += ImTextCharFromUtf8(&c, s, text_end); + if (c == 0) // Malformed UTF-8? + break; + } + + if (c < 32) + { + if (c == '\n') + { + text_size.x = ImMax(text_size.x, line_width); + text_size.y += line_height; + line_width = 0.0f; + continue; + } + if (c == '\r') + continue; + } + + const float char_width = ((int)c < IndexAdvanceX.Size ? IndexAdvanceX.Data[c] : FallbackAdvanceX) * scale; + if (line_width + char_width >= max_width) + { + s = prev_s; + break; + } + + line_width += char_width; + } + + if (text_size.x < line_width) + text_size.x = line_width; + + if (line_width > 0 || text_size.y == 0.0f) + text_size.y += line_height; + + if (remaining) + *remaining = s; + + return text_size; +} + +// Note: as with every ImDrawList drawing function, this expects that the font atlas texture is bound. +void ImFont::RenderChar(ImDrawList* draw_list, float size, ImVec2 pos, ImU32 col, ImWchar c) const +{ + const ImFontGlyph* glyph = FindGlyph(c); + if (!glyph || !glyph->Visible) + return; + if (glyph->Colored) + col |= ~IM_COL32_A_MASK; + float scale = (size >= 0.0f) ? (size / FontSize) : 1.0f; + pos.x = IM_FLOOR(pos.x); + pos.y = IM_FLOOR(pos.y); + draw_list->PrimReserve(6, 4); + draw_list->PrimRectUV(ImVec2(pos.x + glyph->X0 * scale, pos.y + glyph->Y0 * scale), ImVec2(pos.x + glyph->X1 * scale, pos.y + glyph->Y1 * scale), ImVec2(glyph->U0, glyph->V0), ImVec2(glyph->U1, glyph->V1), col); +} + +// Note: as with every ImDrawList drawing function, this expects that the font atlas texture is bound. +void ImFont::RenderText(ImDrawList* draw_list, float size, ImVec2 pos, ImU32 col, const ImVec4& clip_rect, const char* text_begin, const char* text_end, float wrap_width, bool cpu_fine_clip) const +{ + if (!text_end) + text_end = text_begin + strlen(text_begin); // ImGui:: functions generally already provides a valid text_end, so this is merely to handle direct calls. + + // Align to be pixel perfect + pos.x = IM_FLOOR(pos.x); + pos.y = IM_FLOOR(pos.y); + float x = pos.x; + float y = pos.y; + if (y > clip_rect.w) + return; + + const float scale = size / FontSize; + const float line_height = FontSize * scale; + const bool word_wrap_enabled = (wrap_width > 0.0f); + const char* word_wrap_eol = NULL; + + // Fast-forward to first visible line + const char* s = text_begin; + if (y + line_height < clip_rect.y && !word_wrap_enabled) + while (y + line_height < clip_rect.y && s < text_end) + { + s = (const char*)memchr(s, '\n', text_end - s); + s = s ? s + 1 : text_end; + y += line_height; + } + + // For large text, scan for the last visible line in order to avoid over-reserving in the call to PrimReserve() + // Note that very large horizontal line will still be affected by the issue (e.g. a one megabyte string buffer without a newline will likely crash atm) + if (text_end - s > 10000 && !word_wrap_enabled) + { + const char* s_end = s; + float y_end = y; + while (y_end < clip_rect.w && s_end < text_end) + { + s_end = (const char*)memchr(s_end, '\n', text_end - s_end); + s_end = s_end ? s_end + 1 : text_end; + y_end += line_height; + } + text_end = s_end; + } + if (s == text_end) + return; + + // Reserve vertices for remaining worse case (over-reserving is useful and easily amortized) + const int vtx_count_max = (int)(text_end - s) * 4; + const int idx_count_max = (int)(text_end - s) * 6; + const int idx_expected_size = draw_list->IdxBuffer.Size + idx_count_max; + draw_list->PrimReserve(idx_count_max, vtx_count_max); + + ImDrawVert* vtx_write = draw_list->_VtxWritePtr; + ImDrawIdx* idx_write = draw_list->_IdxWritePtr; + unsigned int vtx_current_idx = draw_list->_VtxCurrentIdx; + + const ImU32 col_untinted = col | ~IM_COL32_A_MASK; + + while (s < text_end) + { + if (word_wrap_enabled) + { + // Calculate how far we can render. Requires two passes on the string data but keeps the code simple and not intrusive for what's essentially an uncommon feature. + if (!word_wrap_eol) + { + word_wrap_eol = CalcWordWrapPositionA(scale, s, text_end, wrap_width - (x - pos.x)); + if (word_wrap_eol == s) // Wrap_width is too small to fit anything. Force displaying 1 character to minimize the height discontinuity. + word_wrap_eol++; // +1 may not be a character start point in UTF-8 but it's ok because we use s >= word_wrap_eol below + } + + if (s >= word_wrap_eol) + { + x = pos.x; + y += line_height; + word_wrap_eol = NULL; + + // Wrapping skips upcoming blanks + while (s < text_end) + { + const char c = *s; + if (ImCharIsBlankA(c)) { s++; } else if (c == '\n') { s++; break; } else { break; } + } + continue; + } + } + + // Decode and advance source + unsigned int c = (unsigned int)*s; + if (c < 0x80) + { + s += 1; + } + else + { + s += ImTextCharFromUtf8(&c, s, text_end); + if (c == 0) // Malformed UTF-8? + break; + } + + if (c < 32) + { + if (c == '\n') + { + x = pos.x; + y += line_height; + if (y > clip_rect.w) + break; // break out of main loop + continue; + } + if (c == '\r') + continue; + } + + const ImFontGlyph* glyph = FindGlyph((ImWchar)c); + if (glyph == NULL) + continue; + + float char_width = glyph->AdvanceX * scale; + if (glyph->Visible) + { + // We don't do a second finer clipping test on the Y axis as we've already skipped anything before clip_rect.y and exit once we pass clip_rect.w + float x1 = x + glyph->X0 * scale; + float x2 = x + glyph->X1 * scale; + float y1 = y + glyph->Y0 * scale; + float y2 = y + glyph->Y1 * scale; + if (x1 <= clip_rect.z && x2 >= clip_rect.x) + { + // Render a character + float u1 = glyph->U0; + float v1 = glyph->V0; + float u2 = glyph->U1; + float v2 = glyph->V1; + + // CPU side clipping used to fit text in their frame when the frame is too small. Only does clipping for axis aligned quads. + if (cpu_fine_clip) + { + if (x1 < clip_rect.x) + { + u1 = u1 + (1.0f - (x2 - clip_rect.x) / (x2 - x1)) * (u2 - u1); + x1 = clip_rect.x; + } + if (y1 < clip_rect.y) + { + v1 = v1 + (1.0f - (y2 - clip_rect.y) / (y2 - y1)) * (v2 - v1); + y1 = clip_rect.y; + } + if (x2 > clip_rect.z) + { + u2 = u1 + ((clip_rect.z - x1) / (x2 - x1)) * (u2 - u1); + x2 = clip_rect.z; + } + if (y2 > clip_rect.w) + { + v2 = v1 + ((clip_rect.w - y1) / (y2 - y1)) * (v2 - v1); + y2 = clip_rect.w; + } + if (y1 >= y2) + { + x += char_width; + continue; + } + } + + // Support for untinted glyphs + ImU32 glyph_col = glyph->Colored ? col_untinted : col; + + // We are NOT calling PrimRectUV() here because non-inlined causes too much overhead in a debug builds. Inlined here: + { + idx_write[0] = (ImDrawIdx)(vtx_current_idx); idx_write[1] = (ImDrawIdx)(vtx_current_idx+1); idx_write[2] = (ImDrawIdx)(vtx_current_idx+2); + idx_write[3] = (ImDrawIdx)(vtx_current_idx); idx_write[4] = (ImDrawIdx)(vtx_current_idx+2); idx_write[5] = (ImDrawIdx)(vtx_current_idx+3); + vtx_write[0].pos.x = x1; vtx_write[0].pos.y = y1; vtx_write[0].col = glyph_col; vtx_write[0].uv.x = u1; vtx_write[0].uv.y = v1; + vtx_write[1].pos.x = x2; vtx_write[1].pos.y = y1; vtx_write[1].col = glyph_col; vtx_write[1].uv.x = u2; vtx_write[1].uv.y = v1; + vtx_write[2].pos.x = x2; vtx_write[2].pos.y = y2; vtx_write[2].col = glyph_col; vtx_write[2].uv.x = u2; vtx_write[2].uv.y = v2; + vtx_write[3].pos.x = x1; vtx_write[3].pos.y = y2; vtx_write[3].col = glyph_col; vtx_write[3].uv.x = u1; vtx_write[3].uv.y = v2; + vtx_write += 4; + vtx_current_idx += 4; + idx_write += 6; + } + } + } + x += char_width; + } + + // Give back unused vertices (clipped ones, blanks) ~ this is essentially a PrimUnreserve() action. + draw_list->VtxBuffer.Size = (int)(vtx_write - draw_list->VtxBuffer.Data); // Same as calling shrink() + draw_list->IdxBuffer.Size = (int)(idx_write - draw_list->IdxBuffer.Data); + draw_list->CmdBuffer[draw_list->CmdBuffer.Size - 1].ElemCount -= (idx_expected_size - draw_list->IdxBuffer.Size); + draw_list->_VtxWritePtr = vtx_write; + draw_list->_IdxWritePtr = idx_write; + draw_list->_VtxCurrentIdx = vtx_current_idx; +} + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] ImGui Internal Render Helpers +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// Vaguely redesigned to stop accessing ImGui global state: +// - RenderArrow() +// - RenderBullet() +// - RenderCheckMark() +// - RenderMouseCursor() +// - RenderArrowPointingAt() +// - RenderRectFilledRangeH() +// - RenderRectFilledWithHole() +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// Function in need of a redesign (legacy mess) +// - RenderColorRectWithAlphaCheckerboard() +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// Render an arrow aimed to be aligned with text (p_min is a position in the same space text would be positioned). To e.g. denote expanded/collapsed state +void ImGui::RenderArrow(ImDrawList* draw_list, ImVec2 pos, ImU32 col, ImGuiDir dir, float scale) +{ + const float h = draw_list->_Data->FontSize * 1.00f; + float r = h * 0.40f * scale; + ImVec2 center = pos + ImVec2(h * 0.50f, h * 0.50f * scale); + + ImVec2 a, b, c; + switch (dir) + { + case ImGuiDir_Up: + case ImGuiDir_Down: + if (dir == ImGuiDir_Up) r = -r; + a = ImVec2(+0.000f, +0.750f) * r; + b = ImVec2(-0.866f, -0.750f) * r; + c = ImVec2(+0.866f, -0.750f) * r; + break; + case ImGuiDir_Left: + case ImGuiDir_Right: + if (dir == ImGuiDir_Left) r = -r; + a = ImVec2(+0.750f, +0.000f) * r; + b = ImVec2(-0.750f, +0.866f) * r; + c = ImVec2(-0.750f, -0.866f) * r; + break; + case ImGuiDir_None: + case ImGuiDir_COUNT: + IM_ASSERT(0); + break; + } + draw_list->AddTriangleFilled(center + a, center + b, center + c, col); +} + +void ImGui::RenderBullet(ImDrawList* draw_list, ImVec2 pos, ImU32 col) +{ + draw_list->AddCircleFilled(pos, draw_list->_Data->FontSize * 0.20f, col, 8); +} + +void ImGui::RenderCheckMark(ImDrawList* draw_list, ImVec2 pos, ImU32 col, float sz) +{ + float thickness = ImMax(sz / 5.0f, 1.0f); + sz -= thickness * 0.5f; + pos += ImVec2(thickness * 0.25f, thickness * 0.25f); + + float third = sz / 3.0f; + float bx = pos.x + third; + float by = pos.y + sz - third * 0.5f; + draw_list->PathLineTo(ImVec2(bx - third, by - third)); + draw_list->PathLineTo(ImVec2(bx, by)); + draw_list->PathLineTo(ImVec2(bx + third * 2.0f, by - third * 2.0f)); + draw_list->PathStroke(col, 0, thickness); +} + +void ImGui::RenderMouseCursor(ImDrawList* draw_list, ImVec2 pos, float scale, ImGuiMouseCursor mouse_cursor, ImU32 col_fill, ImU32 col_border, ImU32 col_shadow) +{ + if (mouse_cursor == ImGuiMouseCursor_None) + return; + IM_ASSERT(mouse_cursor > ImGuiMouseCursor_None && mouse_cursor < ImGuiMouseCursor_COUNT); + + ImFontAtlas* font_atlas = draw_list->_Data->Font->ContainerAtlas; + ImVec2 offset, size, uv[4]; + if (font_atlas->GetMouseCursorTexData(mouse_cursor, &offset, &size, &uv[0], &uv[2])) + { + pos -= offset; + ImTextureID tex_id = font_atlas->TexID; + draw_list->PushTextureID(tex_id); + draw_list->AddImage(tex_id, pos + ImVec2(1, 0) * scale, pos + (ImVec2(1, 0) + size) * scale, uv[2], uv[3], col_shadow); + draw_list->AddImage(tex_id, pos + ImVec2(2, 0) * scale, pos + (ImVec2(2, 0) + size) * scale, uv[2], uv[3], col_shadow); + draw_list->AddImage(tex_id, pos, pos + size * scale, uv[2], uv[3], col_border); + draw_list->AddImage(tex_id, pos, pos + size * scale, uv[0], uv[1], col_fill); + draw_list->PopTextureID(); + } +} + +// Render an arrow. 'pos' is position of the arrow tip. half_sz.x is length from base to tip. half_sz.y is length on each side. +void ImGui::RenderArrowPointingAt(ImDrawList* draw_list, ImVec2 pos, ImVec2 half_sz, ImGuiDir direction, ImU32 col) +{ + switch (direction) + { + case ImGuiDir_Left: draw_list->AddTriangleFilled(ImVec2(pos.x + half_sz.x, pos.y - half_sz.y), ImVec2(pos.x + half_sz.x, pos.y + half_sz.y), pos, col); return; + case ImGuiDir_Right: draw_list->AddTriangleFilled(ImVec2(pos.x - half_sz.x, pos.y + half_sz.y), ImVec2(pos.x - half_sz.x, pos.y - half_sz.y), pos, col); return; + case ImGuiDir_Up: draw_list->AddTriangleFilled(ImVec2(pos.x + half_sz.x, pos.y + half_sz.y), ImVec2(pos.x - half_sz.x, pos.y + half_sz.y), pos, col); return; + case ImGuiDir_Down: draw_list->AddTriangleFilled(ImVec2(pos.x - half_sz.x, pos.y - half_sz.y), ImVec2(pos.x + half_sz.x, pos.y - half_sz.y), pos, col); return; + case ImGuiDir_None: case ImGuiDir_COUNT: break; // Fix warnings + } +} + +static inline float ImAcos01(float x) +{ + if (x <= 0.0f) return IM_PI * 0.5f; + if (x >= 1.0f) return 0.0f; + return ImAcos(x); + //return (-0.69813170079773212f * x * x - 0.87266462599716477f) * x + 1.5707963267948966f; // Cheap approximation, may be enough for what we do. +} + +// FIXME: Cleanup and move code to ImDrawList. +void ImGui::RenderRectFilledRangeH(ImDrawList* draw_list, const ImRect& rect, ImU32 col, float x_start_norm, float x_end_norm, float rounding) +{ + if (x_end_norm == x_start_norm) + return; + if (x_start_norm > x_end_norm) + ImSwap(x_start_norm, x_end_norm); + + ImVec2 p0 = ImVec2(ImLerp(rect.Min.x, rect.Max.x, x_start_norm), rect.Min.y); + ImVec2 p1 = ImVec2(ImLerp(rect.Min.x, rect.Max.x, x_end_norm), rect.Max.y); + if (rounding == 0.0f) + { + draw_list->AddRectFilled(p0, p1, col, 0.0f); + return; + } + + rounding = ImClamp(ImMin((rect.Max.x - rect.Min.x) * 0.5f, (rect.Max.y - rect.Min.y) * 0.5f) - 1.0f, 0.0f, rounding); + const float inv_rounding = 1.0f / rounding; + const float arc0_b = ImAcos01(1.0f - (p0.x - rect.Min.x) * inv_rounding); + const float arc0_e = ImAcos01(1.0f - (p1.x - rect.Min.x) * inv_rounding); + const float half_pi = IM_PI * 0.5f; // We will == compare to this because we know this is the exact value ImAcos01 can return. + const float x0 = ImMax(p0.x, rect.Min.x + rounding); + if (arc0_b == arc0_e) + { + draw_list->PathLineTo(ImVec2(x0, p1.y)); + draw_list->PathLineTo(ImVec2(x0, p0.y)); + } + else if (arc0_b == 0.0f && arc0_e == half_pi) + { + draw_list->PathArcToFast(ImVec2(x0, p1.y - rounding), rounding, 3, 6); // BL + draw_list->PathArcToFast(ImVec2(x0, p0.y + rounding), rounding, 6, 9); // TR + } + else + { + draw_list->PathArcTo(ImVec2(x0, p1.y - rounding), rounding, IM_PI - arc0_e, IM_PI - arc0_b, 3); // BL + draw_list->PathArcTo(ImVec2(x0, p0.y + rounding), rounding, IM_PI + arc0_b, IM_PI + arc0_e, 3); // TR + } + if (p1.x > rect.Min.x + rounding) + { + const float arc1_b = ImAcos01(1.0f - (rect.Max.x - p1.x) * inv_rounding); + const float arc1_e = ImAcos01(1.0f - (rect.Max.x - p0.x) * inv_rounding); + const float x1 = ImMin(p1.x, rect.Max.x - rounding); + if (arc1_b == arc1_e) + { + draw_list->PathLineTo(ImVec2(x1, p0.y)); + draw_list->PathLineTo(ImVec2(x1, p1.y)); + } + else if (arc1_b == 0.0f && arc1_e == half_pi) + { + draw_list->PathArcToFast(ImVec2(x1, p0.y + rounding), rounding, 9, 12); // TR + draw_list->PathArcToFast(ImVec2(x1, p1.y - rounding), rounding, 0, 3); // BR + } + else + { + draw_list->PathArcTo(ImVec2(x1, p0.y + rounding), rounding, -arc1_e, -arc1_b, 3); // TR + draw_list->PathArcTo(ImVec2(x1, p1.y - rounding), rounding, +arc1_b, +arc1_e, 3); // BR + } + } + draw_list->PathFillConvex(col); +} + +void ImGui::RenderRectFilledWithHole(ImDrawList* draw_list, ImRect outer, ImRect inner, ImU32 col, float rounding) +{ + const bool fill_L = (inner.Min.x > outer.Min.x); + const bool fill_R = (inner.Max.x < outer.Max.x); + const bool fill_U = (inner.Min.y > outer.Min.y); + const bool fill_D = (inner.Max.y < outer.Max.y); + if (fill_L) draw_list->AddRectFilled(ImVec2(outer.Min.x, inner.Min.y), ImVec2(inner.Min.x, inner.Max.y), col, rounding, (fill_U ? 0 : ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersTopLeft) | (fill_D ? 0 : ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersBottomLeft)); + if (fill_R) draw_list->AddRectFilled(ImVec2(inner.Max.x, inner.Min.y), ImVec2(outer.Max.x, inner.Max.y), col, rounding, (fill_U ? 0 : ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersTopRight) | (fill_D ? 0 : ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersBottomRight)); + if (fill_U) draw_list->AddRectFilled(ImVec2(inner.Min.x, outer.Min.y), ImVec2(inner.Max.x, inner.Min.y), col, rounding, (fill_L ? 0 : ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersTopLeft) | (fill_R ? 0 : ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersTopRight)); + if (fill_D) draw_list->AddRectFilled(ImVec2(inner.Min.x, inner.Max.y), ImVec2(inner.Max.x, outer.Max.y), col, rounding, (fill_L ? 0 : ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersBottomLeft) | (fill_R ? 0 : ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersBottomRight)); + if (fill_L && fill_U) draw_list->AddRectFilled(ImVec2(outer.Min.x, outer.Min.y), ImVec2(inner.Min.x, inner.Min.y), col, rounding, ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersTopLeft); + if (fill_R && fill_U) draw_list->AddRectFilled(ImVec2(inner.Max.x, outer.Min.y), ImVec2(outer.Max.x, inner.Min.y), col, rounding, ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersTopRight); + if (fill_L && fill_D) draw_list->AddRectFilled(ImVec2(outer.Min.x, inner.Max.y), ImVec2(inner.Min.x, outer.Max.y), col, rounding, ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersBottomLeft); + if (fill_R && fill_D) draw_list->AddRectFilled(ImVec2(inner.Max.x, inner.Max.y), ImVec2(outer.Max.x, outer.Max.y), col, rounding, ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersBottomRight); +} + +// Helper for ColorPicker4() +// NB: This is rather brittle and will show artifact when rounding this enabled if rounded corners overlap multiple cells. Caller currently responsible for avoiding that. +// Spent a non reasonable amount of time trying to getting this right for ColorButton with rounding+anti-aliasing+ImGuiColorEditFlags_HalfAlphaPreview flag + various grid sizes and offsets, and eventually gave up... probably more reasonable to disable rounding altogether. +// FIXME: uses ImGui::GetColorU32 +void ImGui::RenderColorRectWithAlphaCheckerboard(ImDrawList* draw_list, ImVec2 p_min, ImVec2 p_max, ImU32 col, float grid_step, ImVec2 grid_off, float rounding, ImDrawFlags flags) +{ + if ((flags & ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersMask_) == 0) + flags = ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersDefault_; + if (((col & IM_COL32_A_MASK) >> IM_COL32_A_SHIFT) < 0xFF) + { + ImU32 col_bg1 = GetColorU32(ImAlphaBlendColors(IM_COL32(204, 204, 204, 255), col)); + ImU32 col_bg2 = GetColorU32(ImAlphaBlendColors(IM_COL32(128, 128, 128, 255), col)); + draw_list->AddRectFilled(p_min, p_max, col_bg1, rounding, flags); + + int yi = 0; + for (float y = p_min.y + grid_off.y; y < p_max.y; y += grid_step, yi++) + { + float y1 = ImClamp(y, p_min.y, p_max.y), y2 = ImMin(y + grid_step, p_max.y); + if (y2 <= y1) + continue; + for (float x = p_min.x + grid_off.x + (yi & 1) * grid_step; x < p_max.x; x += grid_step * 2.0f) + { + float x1 = ImClamp(x, p_min.x, p_max.x), x2 = ImMin(x + grid_step, p_max.x); + if (x2 <= x1) + continue; + ImDrawFlags cell_flags = ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersNone; + if (y1 <= p_min.y) { if (x1 <= p_min.x) cell_flags |= ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersTopLeft; if (x2 >= p_max.x) cell_flags |= ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersTopRight; } + if (y2 >= p_max.y) { if (x1 <= p_min.x) cell_flags |= ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersBottomLeft; if (x2 >= p_max.x) cell_flags |= ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersBottomRight; } + + // Combine flags + cell_flags = (flags == ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersNone || cell_flags == ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersNone) ? ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersNone : (cell_flags & flags); + draw_list->AddRectFilled(ImVec2(x1, y1), ImVec2(x2, y2), col_bg2, rounding, cell_flags); + } + } + } + else + { + draw_list->AddRectFilled(p_min, p_max, col, rounding, flags); + } +} + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Decompression code +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// Compressed with stb_compress() then converted to a C array and encoded as base85. +// Use the program in misc/fonts/binary_to_compressed_c.cpp to create the array from a TTF file. +// The purpose of encoding as base85 instead of "0x00,0x01,..." style is only save on _source code_ size. +// Decompression from stb.h (public domain) by Sean Barrett https://github.com/nothings/stb/blob/master/stb.h +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +static unsigned int stb_decompress_length(const unsigned char *input) +{ + return (input[8] << 24) + (input[9] << 16) + (input[10] << 8) + input[11]; +} + +static unsigned char *stb__barrier_out_e, *stb__barrier_out_b; +static const unsigned char *stb__barrier_in_b; +static unsigned char *stb__dout; +static void stb__match(const unsigned char *data, unsigned int length) +{ + // INVERSE of memmove... write each byte before copying the next... + IM_ASSERT(stb__dout + length <= stb__barrier_out_e); + if (stb__dout + length > stb__barrier_out_e) { stb__dout += length; return; } + if (data < stb__barrier_out_b) { stb__dout = stb__barrier_out_e+1; return; } + while (length--) *stb__dout++ = *data++; +} + +static void stb__lit(const unsigned char *data, unsigned int length) +{ + IM_ASSERT(stb__dout + length <= stb__barrier_out_e); + if (stb__dout + length > stb__barrier_out_e) { stb__dout += length; return; } + if (data < stb__barrier_in_b) { stb__dout = stb__barrier_out_e+1; return; } + memcpy(stb__dout, data, length); + stb__dout += length; +} + +#define stb__in2(x) ((i[x] << 8) + i[(x)+1]) +#define stb__in3(x) ((i[x] << 16) + stb__in2((x)+1)) +#define stb__in4(x) ((i[x] << 24) + stb__in3((x)+1)) + +static const unsigned char *stb_decompress_token(const unsigned char *i) +{ + if (*i >= 0x20) { // use fewer if's for cases that expand small + if (*i >= 0x80) stb__match(stb__dout-i[1]-1, i[0] - 0x80 + 1), i += 2; + else if (*i >= 0x40) stb__match(stb__dout-(stb__in2(0) - 0x4000 + 1), i[2]+1), i += 3; + else /* *i >= 0x20 */ stb__lit(i+1, i[0] - 0x20 + 1), i += 1 + (i[0] - 0x20 + 1); + } else { // more ifs for cases that expand large, since overhead is amortized + if (*i >= 0x18) stb__match(stb__dout-(stb__in3(0) - 0x180000 + 1), i[3]+1), i += 4; + else if (*i >= 0x10) stb__match(stb__dout-(stb__in3(0) - 0x100000 + 1), stb__in2(3)+1), i += 5; + else if (*i >= 0x08) stb__lit(i+2, stb__in2(0) - 0x0800 + 1), i += 2 + (stb__in2(0) - 0x0800 + 1); + else if (*i == 0x07) stb__lit(i+3, stb__in2(1) + 1), i += 3 + (stb__in2(1) + 1); + else if (*i == 0x06) stb__match(stb__dout-(stb__in3(1)+1), i[4]+1), i += 5; + else if (*i == 0x04) stb__match(stb__dout-(stb__in3(1)+1), stb__in2(4)+1), i += 6; + } + return i; +} + +static unsigned int stb_adler32(unsigned int adler32, unsigned char *buffer, unsigned int buflen) +{ + const unsigned long ADLER_MOD = 65521; + unsigned long s1 = adler32 & 0xffff, s2 = adler32 >> 16; + unsigned long blocklen = buflen % 5552; + + unsigned long i; + while (buflen) { + for (i=0; i + 7 < blocklen; i += 8) { + s1 += buffer[0], s2 += s1; + s1 += buffer[1], s2 += s1; + s1 += buffer[2], s2 += s1; + s1 += buffer[3], s2 += s1; + s1 += buffer[4], s2 += s1; + s1 += buffer[5], s2 += s1; + s1 += buffer[6], s2 += s1; + s1 += buffer[7], s2 += s1; + + buffer += 8; + } + + for (; i < blocklen; ++i) + s1 += *buffer++, s2 += s1; + + s1 %= ADLER_MOD, s2 %= ADLER_MOD; + buflen -= blocklen; + blocklen = 5552; + } + return (unsigned int)(s2 << 16) + (unsigned int)s1; +} + +static unsigned int stb_decompress(unsigned char *output, const unsigned char *i, unsigned int /*length*/) +{ + if (stb__in4(0) != 0x57bC0000) return 0; + if (stb__in4(4) != 0) return 0; // error! stream is > 4GB + const unsigned int olen = stb_decompress_length(i); + stb__barrier_in_b = i; + stb__barrier_out_e = output + olen; + stb__barrier_out_b = output; + i += 16; + + stb__dout = output; + for (;;) { + const unsigned char *old_i = i; + i = stb_decompress_token(i); + if (i == old_i) { + if (*i == 0x05 && i[1] == 0xfa) { + IM_ASSERT(stb__dout == output + olen); + if (stb__dout != output + olen) return 0; + if (stb_adler32(1, output, olen) != (unsigned int) stb__in4(2)) + return 0; + return olen; + } else { + IM_ASSERT(0); /* NOTREACHED */ + return 0; + } + } + IM_ASSERT(stb__dout <= output + olen); + if (stb__dout > output + olen) + return 0; + } +} + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Default font data (ProggyClean.ttf) +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// ProggyClean.ttf +// Copyright (c) 2004, 2005 Tristan Grimmer +// MIT license (see License.txt in http://www.upperbounds.net/download/ProggyClean.ttf.zip) +// Download and more information at http://upperbounds.net +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// File: 'ProggyClean.ttf' (41208 bytes) +// Exported using misc/fonts/binary_to_compressed_c.cpp (with compression + base85 string encoding). +// The purpose of encoding as base85 instead of "0x00,0x01,..." style is only save on _source code_ size. +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +static const char proggy_clean_ttf_compressed_data_base85[11980 + 1] = + "7])#######hV0qs'/###[),##/l:$#Q6>##5[n42>c-TH`->>#/e>11NNV=Bv(*:.F?uu#(gRU.o0XGH`$vhLG1hxt9?W`#,5LsCp#-i>.r$<$6pD>Lb';9Crc6tgXmKVeU2cD4Eo3R/" + "2*>]b(MC;$jPfY.;h^`IWM9Qo#t'X#(v#Y9w0#1D$CIf;W'#pWUPXOuxXuU(H9M(1=Ke$$'5F%)]0^#0X@U.a$FBjVQTSDgEKnIS7EM9>ZY9w0#L;>>#Mx&4Mvt//L[MkA#W@lK.N'[0#7RL_&#w+F%HtG9M#XL`N&.,GM4Pg;--VsM.M0rJfLH2eTM`*oJMHRC`N" + "kfimM2J,W-jXS:)r0wK#@Fge$U>`w'N7G#$#fB#$E^$#:9:hk+eOe--6x)F7*E%?76%^GMHePW-Z5l'&GiF#$956:rS?dA#fiK:)Yr+`�j@'DbG&#^$PG.Ll+DNa&VZ>1i%h1S9u5o@YaaW$e+bROPOpxTO7Stwi1::iB1q)C_=dV26J;2,]7op$]uQr@_V7$q^%lQwtuHY]=DX,n3L#0PHDO4f9>dC@O>HBuKPpP*E,N+b3L#lpR/MrTEH.IAQk.a>D[.e;mc." + "x]Ip.PH^'/aqUO/$1WxLoW0[iLAw=4h(9.`G" + "CRUxHPeR`5Mjol(dUWxZa(>STrPkrJiWx`5U7F#.g*jrohGg`cg:lSTvEY/EV_7H4Q9[Z%cnv;JQYZ5q.l7Zeas:HOIZOB?Ggv:[7MI2k).'2($5FNP&EQ(,)" + "U]W]+fh18.vsai00);D3@4ku5P?DP8aJt+;qUM]=+b'8@;mViBKx0DE[-auGl8:PJ&Dj+M6OC]O^((##]`0i)drT;-7X`=-H3[igUnPG-NZlo.#k@h#=Ork$m>a>$-?Tm$UV(?#P6YY#" + "'/###xe7q.73rI3*pP/$1>s9)W,JrM7SN]'/4C#v$U`0#V.[0>xQsH$fEmPMgY2u7Kh(G%siIfLSoS+MK2eTM$=5,M8p`A.;_R%#u[K#$x4AG8.kK/HSB==-'Ie/QTtG?-.*^N-4B/ZM" + "_3YlQC7(p7q)&](`6_c)$/*JL(L-^(]$wIM`dPtOdGA,U3:w2M-0+WomX2u7lqM2iEumMTcsF?-aT=Z-97UEnXglEn1K-bnEO`gu" + "Ft(c%=;Am_Qs@jLooI&NX;]0#j4#F14;gl8-GQpgwhrq8'=l_f-b49'UOqkLu7-##oDY2L(te+Mch&gLYtJ,MEtJfLh'x'M=$CS-ZZ%P]8bZ>#S?YY#%Q&q'3^Fw&?D)UDNrocM3A76/" + "/oL?#h7gl85[qW/NDOk%16ij;+:1a'iNIdb-ou8.P*w,v5#EI$TWS>Pot-R*H'-SEpA:g)f+O$%%`kA#G=8RMmG1&O`>to8bC]T&$,n.LoO>29sp3dt-52U%VM#q7'DHpg+#Z9%H[Ket`e;)f#Km8&+DC$I46>#Kr]]u-[=99tts1.qb#q72g1WJO81q+eN'03'eM>&1XxY-caEnO" + "j%2n8)),?ILR5^.Ibn<-X-Mq7[a82Lq:F&#ce+S9wsCK*x`569E8ew'He]h:sI[2LM$[guka3ZRd6:t%IG:;$%YiJ:Nq=?eAw;/:nnDq0(CYcMpG)qLN4$##&J-XTt,%OVU4)S1+R-#dg0/Nn?Ku1^0f$B*P:Rowwm-`0PKjYDDM'3]d39VZHEl4,.j']Pk-M.h^&:0FACm$maq-&sgw0t7/6(^xtk%" + "LuH88Fj-ekm>GA#_>568x6(OFRl-IZp`&b,_P'$MhLbxfc$mj`,O;&%W2m`Zh:/)Uetw:aJ%]K9h:TcF]u_-Sj9,VK3M.*'&0D[Ca]J9gp8,kAW]" + "%(?A%R$f<->Zts'^kn=-^@c4%-pY6qI%J%1IGxfLU9CP8cbPlXv);C=b),<2mOvP8up,UVf3839acAWAW-W?#ao/^#%KYo8fRULNd2.>%m]UK:n%r$'sw]J;5pAoO_#2mO3n,'=H5(et" + "Hg*`+RLgv>=4U8guD$I%D:W>-r5V*%j*W:Kvej.Lp$'?;++O'>()jLR-^u68PHm8ZFWe+ej8h:9r6L*0//c&iH&R8pRbA#Kjm%upV1g:" + "a_#Ur7FuA#(tRh#.Y5K+@?3<-8m0$PEn;J:rh6?I6uG<-`wMU'ircp0LaE_OtlMb&1#6T.#FDKu#1Lw%u%+GM+X'e?YLfjM[VO0MbuFp7;>Q&#WIo)0@F%q7c#4XAXN-U&VBpqB>0ie&jhZ[?iLR@@_AvA-iQC(=ksRZRVp7`.=+NpBC%rh&3]R:8XDmE5^V8O(x<-+k?'(^](H.aREZSi,#1:[IXaZFOm<-ui#qUq2$##Ri;u75OK#(RtaW-K-F`S+cF]uN`-KMQ%rP/Xri.LRcB##=YL3BgM/3M" + "D?@f&1'BW-)Ju#bmmWCMkk&#TR`C,5d>g)F;t,4:@_l8G/5h4vUd%&%950:VXD'QdWoY-F$BtUwmfe$YqL'8(PWX(" + "P?^@Po3$##`MSs?DWBZ/S>+4%>fX,VWv/w'KD`LP5IbH;rTV>n3cEK8U#bX]l-/V+^lj3;vlMb&[5YQ8#pekX9JP3XUC72L,,?+Ni&co7ApnO*5NK,((W-i:$,kp'UDAO(G0Sq7MVjJs" + "bIu)'Z,*[>br5fX^:FPAWr-m2KgLQ_nN6'8uTGT5g)uLv:873UpTLgH+#FgpH'_o1780Ph8KmxQJ8#H72L4@768@Tm&Q" + "h4CB/5OvmA&,Q&QbUoi$a_%3M01H)4x7I^&KQVgtFnV+;[Pc>[m4k//,]1?#`VY[Jr*3&&slRfLiVZJ:]?=K3Sw=[$=uRB?3xk48@aege0jT6'N#(q%.O=?2S]u*(m<-" + "V8J'(1)G][68hW$5'q[GC&5j`TE?m'esFGNRM)j,ffZ?-qx8;->g4t*:CIP/[Qap7/9'#(1sao7w-.qNUdkJ)tCF&#B^;xGvn2r9FEPFFFcL@.iFNkTve$m%#QvQS8U@)2Z+3K:AKM5i" + "sZ88+dKQ)W6>J%CL`.d*(B`-n8D9oK-XV1q['-5k'cAZ69e;D_?$ZPP&s^+7])$*$#@QYi9,5P r+$%CE=68>K8r0=dSC%%(@p7" + ".m7jilQ02'0-VWAgTlGW'b)Tq7VT9q^*^$$.:&N@@" + "$&)WHtPm*5_rO0&e%K&#-30j(E4#'Zb.o/(Tpm$>K'f@[PvFl,hfINTNU6u'0pao7%XUp9]5.>%h`8_=VYbxuel.NTSsJfLacFu3B'lQSu/m6-Oqem8T+oE--$0a/k]uj9EwsG>%veR*" + "hv^BFpQj:K'#SJ,sB-'#](j.Lg92rTw-*n%@/;39rrJF,l#qV%OrtBeC6/,;qB3ebNW[?,Hqj2L.1NP&GjUR=1D8QaS3Up&@*9wP?+lo7b?@%'k4`p0Z$22%K3+iCZj?XJN4Nm&+YF]u" + "@-W$U%VEQ/,,>>#)D#%8cY#YZ?=,`Wdxu/ae&#" + "w6)R89tI#6@s'(6Bf7a&?S=^ZI_kS&ai`&=tE72L_D,;^R)7[$so8lKN%5/$(vdfq7+ebA#" + "u1p]ovUKW&Y%q]'>$1@-[xfn$7ZTp7mM,G,Ko7a&Gu%G[RMxJs[0MM%wci.LFDK)(%:_i2B5CsR8&9Z&#=mPEnm0f`<&c)QL5uJ#%u%lJj+D-r;BoFDoS97h5g)E#o:&S4weDF,9^Hoe`h*L+_a*NrLW-1pG_&2UdB8" + "6e%B/:=>)N4xeW.*wft-;$'58-ESqr#U`'6AQ]m&6/`Z>#S?YY#Vc;r7U2&326d=w&H####?TZ`*4?&.MK?LP8Vxg>$[QXc%QJv92.(Db*B)gb*BM9dM*hJMAo*c&#" + "b0v=Pjer]$gG&JXDf->'StvU7505l9$AFvgYRI^&<^b68?j#q9QX4SM'RO#&sL1IM.rJfLUAj221]d##DW=m83u5;'bYx,*Sl0hL(W;;$doB&O/TQ:(Z^xBdLjLV#*8U_72Lh+2Q8Cj0i:6hp&$C/:p(HK>T8Y[gHQ4`4)'$Ab(Nof%V'8hL&#SfD07&6D@M.*J:;$-rv29'M]8qMv-tLp,'886iaC=Hb*YJoKJ,(j%K=H`K.v9HggqBIiZu'QvBT.#=)0ukruV&.)3=(^1`o*Pj4<-#MJ+gLq9-##@HuZPN0]u:h7.T..G:;$/Usj(T7`Q8tT72LnYl<-qx8;-HV7Q-&Xdx%1a,hC=0u+HlsV>nuIQL-5" + "_>@kXQtMacfD.m-VAb8;IReM3$wf0''hra*so568'Ip&vRs849'MRYSp%:t:h5qSgwpEr$B>Q,;s(C#$)`svQuF$##-D,##,g68@2[T;.XSdN9Qe)rpt._K-#5wF)sP'##p#C0c%-Gb%" + "hd+<-j'Ai*x&&HMkT]C'OSl##5RG[JXaHN;d'uA#x._U;.`PU@(Z3dt4r152@:v,'R.Sj'w#0<-;kPI)FfJ&#AYJ&#//)>-k=m=*XnK$>=)72L]0I%>.G690a:$##<,);?;72#?x9+d;" + "^V'9;jY@;)br#q^YQpx:X#Te$Z^'=-=bGhLf:D6&bNwZ9-ZD#n^9HhLMr5G;']d&6'wYmTFmLq9wI>P(9mI[>kC-ekLC/R&CH+s'B;K-M6$EB%is00:" + "+A4[7xks.LrNk0&E)wILYF@2L'0Nb$+pv<(2.768/FrY&h$^3i&@+G%JT'<-,v`3;_)I9M^AE]CN?Cl2AZg+%4iTpT3$U4O]GKx'm9)b@p7YsvK3w^YR-" + "CdQ*:Ir<($u&)#(&?L9Rg3H)4fiEp^iI9O8KnTj,]H?D*r7'M;PwZ9K0E^k&-cpI;.p/6_vwoFMV<->#%Xi.LxVnrU(4&8/P+:hLSKj$#U%]49t'I:rgMi'FL@a:0Y-uA[39',(vbma*" + "hU%<-SRF`Tt:542R_VV$p@[p8DV[A,?1839FWdFTi1O*H&#(AL8[_P%.M>v^-))qOT*F5Cq0`Ye%+$B6i:7@0IXSsDiWP,##P`%/L-" + "S(qw%sf/@%#B6;/U7K]uZbi^Oc^2n%t<)'mEVE''n`WnJra$^TKvX5B>;_aSEK',(hwa0:i4G?.Bci.(X[?b*($,=-n<.Q%`(X=?+@Am*Js0&=3bh8K]mL69=Lb,OcZV/);TTm8VI;?%OtJ<(b4mq7M6:u?KRdFl*:xP?Yb.5)%w_I?7uk5JC+FS(m#i'k.'a0i)9<7b'fs'59hq$*5Uhv##pi^8+hIEBF`nvo`;'l0.^S1<-wUK2/Coh58KKhLj" + "M=SO*rfO`+qC`W-On.=AJ56>>i2@2LH6A:&5q`?9I3@@'04&p2/LVa*T-4<-i3;M9UvZd+N7>b*eIwg:CC)c<>nO&#$(>.Z-I&J(Q0Hd5Q%7Co-b`-cP)hI;*_F]u`Rb[.j8_Q/<&>uu+VsH$sM9TA%?)(vmJ80),P7E>)tjD%2L=-t#fK[%`v=Q8WlA2);Sa" + ">gXm8YB`1d@K#n]76-a$U,mF%Ul:#/'xoFM9QX-$.QN'>" + "[%$Z$uF6pA6Ki2O5:8w*vP1<-1`[G,)-m#>0`P&#eb#.3i)rtB61(o'$?X3B2Qft^ae_5tKL9MUe9b*sLEQ95C&`=G?@Mj=wh*'3E>=-<)Gt*Iw)'QG:`@I" + "wOf7&]1i'S01B+Ev/Nac#9S;=;YQpg_6U`*kVY39xK,[/6Aj7:'1Bm-_1EYfa1+o&o4hp7KN_Q(OlIo@S%;jVdn0'1h19w,WQhLI)3S#f$2(eb,jr*b;3Vw]*7NH%$c4Vs,eD9>XW8?N]o+(*pgC%/72LV-uW%iewS8W6m2rtCpo'RS1R84=@paTKt)>=%&1[)*vp'u+x,VrwN;&]kuO9JDbg=pO$J*.jVe;u'm0dr9l,<*wMK*Oe=g8lV_KEBFkO'oU]^=[-792#ok,)" + "i]lR8qQ2oA8wcRCZ^7w/Njh;?.stX?Q1>S1q4Bn$)K1<-rGdO'$Wr.Lc.CG)$/*JL4tNR/,SVO3,aUw'DJN:)Ss;wGn9A32ijw%FL+Z0Fn.U9;reSq)bmI32U==5ALuG&#Vf1398/pVo" + "1*c-(aY168o<`JsSbk-,1N;$>0:OUas(3:8Z972LSfF8eb=c-;>SPw7.6hn3m`9^Xkn(r.qS[0;T%&Qc=+STRxX'q1BNk3&*eu2;&8q$&x>Q#Q7^Tf+6<(d%ZVmj2bDi%.3L2n+4W'$P" + "iDDG)g,r%+?,$@?uou5tSe2aN_AQU*'IAO" + "URQ##V^Fv-XFbGM7Fl(N<3DhLGF%q.1rC$#:T__&Pi68%0xi_&[qFJ(77j_&JWoF.V735&T,[R*:xFR*K5>>#`bW-?4Ne_&6Ne_&6Ne_&n`kr-#GJcM6X;uM6X;uM(.a..^2TkL%oR(#" + ";u.T%fAr%4tJ8&><1=GHZ_+m9/#H1F^R#SC#*N=BA9(D?v[UiFY>>^8p,KKF.W]L29uLkLlu/+4T" + "w$)F./^n3+rlo+DB;5sIYGNk+i1t-69Jg--0pao7Sm#K)pdHW&;LuDNH@H>#/X-TI(;P>#,Gc>#0Su>#4`1?#8lC?#xL$#B.`$#F:r$#JF.%#NR@%#R_R%#Vke%#Zww%#_-4^Rh%Sflr-k'MS.o?.5/sWel/wpEM0%3'/1)K^f1-d>G21&v(35>V`39V7A4=onx4" + "A1OY5EI0;6Ibgr6M$HS7Q<)58C5w,;WoA*#[%T*#`1g*#d=#+#hI5+#lUG+#pbY+#tnl+#x$),#&1;,#*=M,#.I`,#2Ur,#6b.-#;w[H#iQtA#m^0B#qjBB#uvTB##-hB#'9$C#+E6C#" + "/QHC#3^ZC#7jmC#;v)D#?,)4kMYD4lVu`4m`:&5niUA5@(A5BA1]PBB:xlBCC=2CDLXMCEUtiCf&0g2'tN?PGT4CPGT4CPGT4CPGT4CPGT4CPGT4CPGT4CP" + "GT4CPGT4CPGT4CPGT4CPGT4CPGT4CP-qekC`.9kEg^+F$kwViFJTB&5KTB&5KTB&5KTB&5KTB&5KTB&5KTB&5KTB&5KTB&5KTB&5KTB&5KTB&5KTB&5KTB&5KTB&5o,^<-28ZI'O?;xp" + "O?;xpO?;xpO?;xpO?;xpO?;xpO?;xpO?;xpO?;xpO?;xpO?;xpO?;xpO?;xpO?;xp;7q-#lLYI:xvD=#"; + +static const char* GetDefaultCompressedFontDataTTFBase85() +{ + return proggy_clean_ttf_compressed_data_base85; +} + +#endif // #ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE diff --git a/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/imgui-1.84.2/imgui_impl_opengl3.cpp b/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/imgui-1.84.2/imgui_impl_opengl3.cpp new file mode 100644 index 0000000..5637a0f --- /dev/null +++ b/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/imgui-1.84.2/imgui_impl_opengl3.cpp @@ -0,0 +1,778 @@ +// dear imgui: Renderer Backend for modern OpenGL with shaders / programmatic pipeline +// - Desktop GL: 2.x 3.x 4.x +// - Embedded GL: ES 2.0 (WebGL 1.0), ES 3.0 (WebGL 2.0) +// This needs to be used along with a Platform Backend (e.g. GLFW, SDL, Win32, custom..) + +// Implemented features: +// [X] Renderer: User texture binding. Use 'GLuint' OpenGL texture identifier as void*/ImTextureID. Read the FAQ about ImTextureID! +// [x] Renderer: Desktop GL only: Support for large meshes (64k+ vertices) with 16-bit indices. + +// You can use unmodified imgui_impl_* files in your project. See examples/ folder for examples of using this. +// Prefer including the entire imgui/ repository into your project (either as a copy or as a submodule), and only build the backends you need. +// If you are new to Dear ImGui, read documentation from the docs/ folder + read the top of imgui.cpp. +// Read online: https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/tree/master/docs + +// CHANGELOG +// (minor and older changes stripped away, please see git history for details) +// 2021-08-23: OpenGL: Fixed ES 3.0 shader ("#version 300 es") use normal precision floats to avoid wobbly rendering at HD resolutions. +// 2021-08-19: OpenGL: Embed and use our own minimal GL loader (imgui_impl_opengl3_loader.h), removing requirement and support for third-party loader. +// 2021-06-29: Reorganized backend to pull data from a single structure to facilitate usage with multiple-contexts (all g_XXXX access changed to bd->XXXX). +// 2021-06-25: OpenGL: Use OES_vertex_array extension on Emscripten + backup/restore current state. +// 2021-06-21: OpenGL: Destroy individual vertex/fragment shader objects right after they are linked into the main shader. +// 2021-05-24: OpenGL: Access GL_CLIP_ORIGIN when "GL_ARB_clip_control" extension is detected, inside of just OpenGL 4.5 version. +// 2021-05-19: OpenGL: Replaced direct access to ImDrawCmd::TextureId with a call to ImDrawCmd::GetTexID(). (will become a requirement) +// 2021-04-06: OpenGL: Don't try to read GL_CLIP_ORIGIN unless we're OpenGL 4.5 or greater. +// 2021-02-18: OpenGL: Change blending equation to preserve alpha in output buffer. +// 2021-01-03: OpenGL: Backup, setup and restore GL_STENCIL_TEST state. +// 2020-10-23: OpenGL: Backup, setup and restore GL_PRIMITIVE_RESTART state. +// 2020-10-15: OpenGL: Use glGetString(GL_VERSION) instead of glGetIntegerv(GL_MAJOR_VERSION, ...) when the later returns zero (e.g. Desktop GL 2.x) +// 2020-09-17: OpenGL: Fix to avoid compiling/calling glBindSampler() on ES or pre 3.3 context which have the defines set by a loader. +// 2020-07-10: OpenGL: Added support for glad2 OpenGL loader. +// 2020-05-08: OpenGL: Made default GLSL version 150 (instead of 130) on OSX. +// 2020-04-21: OpenGL: Fixed handling of glClipControl(GL_UPPER_LEFT) by inverting projection matrix. +// 2020-04-12: OpenGL: Fixed context version check mistakenly testing for 4.0+ instead of 3.2+ to enable ImGuiBackendFlags_RendererHasVtxOffset. +// 2020-03-24: OpenGL: Added support for glbinding 2.x OpenGL loader. +// 2020-01-07: OpenGL: Added support for glbinding 3.x OpenGL loader. +// 2019-10-25: OpenGL: Using a combination of GL define and runtime GL version to decide whether to use glDrawElementsBaseVertex(). Fix building with pre-3.2 GL loaders. +// 2019-09-22: OpenGL: Detect default GL loader using __has_include compiler facility. +// 2019-09-16: OpenGL: Tweak initialization code to allow application calling ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_CreateFontsTexture() before the first NewFrame() call. +// 2019-05-29: OpenGL: Desktop GL only: Added support for large mesh (64K+ vertices), enable ImGuiBackendFlags_RendererHasVtxOffset flag. +// 2019-04-30: OpenGL: Added support for special ImDrawCallback_ResetRenderState callback to reset render state. +// 2019-03-29: OpenGL: Not calling glBindBuffer more than necessary in the render loop. +// 2019-03-15: OpenGL: Added a GL call + comments in ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_Init() to detect uninitialized GL function loaders early. +// 2019-03-03: OpenGL: Fix support for ES 2.0 (WebGL 1.0). +// 2019-02-20: OpenGL: Fix for OSX not supporting OpenGL 4.5, we don't try to read GL_CLIP_ORIGIN even if defined by the headers/loader. +// 2019-02-11: OpenGL: Projecting clipping rectangles correctly using draw_data->FramebufferScale to allow multi-viewports for retina display. +// 2019-02-01: OpenGL: Using GLSL 410 shaders for any version over 410 (e.g. 430, 450). +// 2018-11-30: Misc: Setting up io.BackendRendererName so it can be displayed in the About Window. +// 2018-11-13: OpenGL: Support for GL 4.5's glClipControl(GL_UPPER_LEFT) / GL_CLIP_ORIGIN. +// 2018-08-29: OpenGL: Added support for more OpenGL loaders: glew and glad, with comments indicative that any loader can be used. +// 2018-08-09: OpenGL: Default to OpenGL ES 3 on iOS and Android. GLSL version default to "#version 300 ES". +// 2018-07-30: OpenGL: Support for GLSL 300 ES and 410 core. Fixes for Emscripten compilation. +// 2018-07-10: OpenGL: Support for more GLSL versions (based on the GLSL version string). Added error output when shaders fail to compile/link. +// 2018-06-08: Misc: Extracted imgui_impl_opengl3.cpp/.h away from the old combined GLFW/SDL+OpenGL3 examples. +// 2018-06-08: OpenGL: Use draw_data->DisplayPos and draw_data->DisplaySize to setup projection matrix and clipping rectangle. +// 2018-05-25: OpenGL: Removed unnecessary backup/restore of GL_ELEMENT_ARRAY_BUFFER_BINDING since this is part of the VAO state. +// 2018-05-14: OpenGL: Making the call to glBindSampler() optional so 3.2 context won't fail if the function is a NULL pointer. +// 2018-03-06: OpenGL: Added const char* glsl_version parameter to ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_Init() so user can override the GLSL version e.g. "#version 150". +// 2018-02-23: OpenGL: Create the VAO in the render function so the setup can more easily be used with multiple shared GL context. +// 2018-02-16: Misc: Obsoleted the io.RenderDrawListsFn callback and exposed ImGui_ImplSdlGL3_RenderDrawData() in the .h file so you can call it yourself. +// 2018-01-07: OpenGL: Changed GLSL shader version from 330 to 150. +// 2017-09-01: OpenGL: Save and restore current bound sampler. Save and restore current polygon mode. +// 2017-05-01: OpenGL: Fixed save and restore of current blend func state. +// 2017-05-01: OpenGL: Fixed save and restore of current GL_ACTIVE_TEXTURE. +// 2016-09-05: OpenGL: Fixed save and restore of current scissor rectangle. +// 2016-07-29: OpenGL: Explicitly setting GL_UNPACK_ROW_LENGTH to reduce issues because SDL changes it. (#752) + +//---------------------------------------- +// OpenGL GLSL GLSL +// version version string +//---------------------------------------- +// 2.0 110 "#version 110" +// 2.1 120 "#version 120" +// 3.0 130 "#version 130" +// 3.1 140 "#version 140" +// 3.2 150 "#version 150" +// 3.3 330 "#version 330 core" +// 4.0 400 "#version 400 core" +// 4.1 410 "#version 410 core" +// 4.2 420 "#version 410 core" +// 4.3 430 "#version 430 core" +// ES 2.0 100 "#version 100" = WebGL 1.0 +// ES 3.0 300 "#version 300 es" = WebGL 2.0 +//---------------------------------------- + +#if defined(_MSC_VER) && !defined(_CRT_SECURE_NO_WARNINGS) +#define _CRT_SECURE_NO_WARNINGS +#endif + +#include "imgui.h" +#include "imgui_impl_opengl3.h" +#include +#if defined(_MSC_VER) && _MSC_VER <= 1500 // MSVC 2008 or earlier +#include // intptr_t +#else +#include // intptr_t +#endif + +// GL includes +#if defined(IMGUI_IMPL_OPENGL_ES2) +#include +#if defined(__EMSCRIPTEN__) +#ifndef GL_GLEXT_PROTOTYPES +#define GL_GLEXT_PROTOTYPES +#endif +#include +#endif +#elif defined(IMGUI_IMPL_OPENGL_ES3) +#if (defined(__APPLE__) && (TARGET_OS_IOS || TARGET_OS_TV)) +#include // Use GL ES 3 +#else +#include // Use GL ES 3 +#endif +#elif !defined(IMGUI_IMPL_OPENGL_LOADER_CUSTOM) +// Modern desktop OpenGL doesn't have a standard portable header file to load OpenGL function pointers. +// Helper libraries are often used for this purpose! Here we are using our own minimal custom loader based on gl3w. +// In the rest of your app/engine, you can use another loader of your choice (gl3w, glew, glad, glbinding, glext, glLoadGen, etc.). +// If you happen to be developing a new feature for this backend (imgui_impl_opengl3.cpp): +// - You may need to regenerate imgui_impl_opengl3_loader.h to add new symbols. See https://github.com/dearimgui/gl3w_stripped +// - You can temporarily use an unstripped version. See https://github.com/dearimgui/gl3w_stripped/releases +// Changes to this backend using new APIs should be accompanied by a regenerated stripped loader version. +#define IMGL3W_IMPL +#include "imgui_impl_opengl3_loader.h" +#endif + +// Vertex arrays are not supported on ES2/WebGL1 unless Emscripten which uses an extension +#ifndef IMGUI_IMPL_OPENGL_ES2 +#define IMGUI_IMPL_OPENGL_USE_VERTEX_ARRAY +#elif defined(__EMSCRIPTEN__) +#define IMGUI_IMPL_OPENGL_USE_VERTEX_ARRAY +#define glBindVertexArray glBindVertexArrayOES +#define glGenVertexArrays glGenVertexArraysOES +#define glDeleteVertexArrays glDeleteVertexArraysOES +#define GL_VERTEX_ARRAY_BINDING GL_VERTEX_ARRAY_BINDING_OES +#endif + +// Desktop GL 2.0+ has glPolygonMode() which GL ES and WebGL don't have. +#ifdef GL_POLYGON_MODE +#define IMGUI_IMPL_HAS_POLYGON_MODE +#endif + +// Desktop GL 3.2+ has glDrawElementsBaseVertex() which GL ES and WebGL don't have. +#if !defined(IMGUI_IMPL_OPENGL_ES2) && !defined(IMGUI_IMPL_OPENGL_ES3) && defined(GL_VERSION_3_2) +#define IMGUI_IMPL_OPENGL_MAY_HAVE_VTX_OFFSET +#endif + +// Desktop GL 3.3+ has glBindSampler() +#if !defined(IMGUI_IMPL_OPENGL_ES2) && !defined(IMGUI_IMPL_OPENGL_ES3) && defined(GL_VERSION_3_3) +#define IMGUI_IMPL_OPENGL_MAY_HAVE_BIND_SAMPLER +#endif + +// Desktop GL 3.1+ has GL_PRIMITIVE_RESTART state +#if !defined(IMGUI_IMPL_OPENGL_ES2) && !defined(IMGUI_IMPL_OPENGL_ES3) && defined(GL_VERSION_3_1) +#define IMGUI_IMPL_OPENGL_MAY_HAVE_PRIMITIVE_RESTART +#endif + +// Desktop GL use extension detection +#if !defined(IMGUI_IMPL_OPENGL_ES2) && !defined(IMGUI_IMPL_OPENGL_ES3) +#define IMGUI_IMPL_OPENGL_MAY_HAVE_EXTENSIONS +#endif + +// OpenGL Data +struct ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_Data +{ + GLuint GlVersion; // Extracted at runtime using GL_MAJOR_VERSION, GL_MINOR_VERSION queries (e.g. 320 for GL 3.2) + char GlslVersionString[32]; // Specified by user or detected based on compile time GL settings. + GLuint FontTexture; + GLuint ShaderHandle; + GLint AttribLocationTex; // Uniforms location + GLint AttribLocationProjMtx; + GLuint AttribLocationVtxPos; // Vertex attributes location + GLuint AttribLocationVtxUV; + GLuint AttribLocationVtxColor; + unsigned int VboHandle, ElementsHandle; + bool HasClipOrigin; + + ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_Data() { memset(this, 0, sizeof(*this)); } +}; + +// Backend data stored in io.BackendRendererUserData to allow support for multiple Dear ImGui contexts +// It is STRONGLY preferred that you use docking branch with multi-viewports (== single Dear ImGui context + multiple windows) instead of multiple Dear ImGui contexts. +static ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_Data* ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_GetBackendData() +{ + return ImGui::GetCurrentContext() ? (ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_Data*)ImGui::GetIO().BackendRendererUserData : NULL; +} + +// Functions +bool ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_Init(const char* glsl_version) +{ + ImGuiIO& io = ImGui::GetIO(); + IM_ASSERT(io.BackendRendererUserData == NULL && "Already initialized a renderer backend!"); + + // Initialize our loader +#if !defined(IMGUI_IMPL_OPENGL_ES2) && !defined(IMGUI_IMPL_OPENGL_ES3) && !defined(IMGUI_IMPL_OPENGL_LOADER_CUSTOM) + if (imgl3wInit() != 0) + { + fprintf(stderr, "Failed to initialize OpenGL loader!\n"); + return false; + } +#endif + + // Setup backend capabilities flags + ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_Data* bd = IM_NEW(ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_Data)(); + io.BackendRendererUserData = (void*)bd; + io.BackendRendererName = "imgui_impl_opengl3"; + + // Query for GL version (e.g. 320 for GL 3.2) +#if !defined(IMGUI_IMPL_OPENGL_ES2) + GLint major = 0; + GLint minor = 0; + glGetIntegerv(GL_MAJOR_VERSION, &major); + glGetIntegerv(GL_MINOR_VERSION, &minor); + if (major == 0 && minor == 0) + { + // Query GL_VERSION in desktop GL 2.x, the string will start with "." + const char* gl_version = (const char*)glGetString(GL_VERSION); + sscanf(gl_version, "%d.%d", &major, &minor); + } + bd->GlVersion = (GLuint)(major * 100 + minor * 10); +#else + bd->GlVersion = 200; // GLES 2 +#endif + +#ifdef IMGUI_IMPL_OPENGL_MAY_HAVE_VTX_OFFSET + if (bd->GlVersion >= 320) + io.BackendFlags |= ImGuiBackendFlags_RendererHasVtxOffset; // We can honor the ImDrawCmd::VtxOffset field, allowing for large meshes. +#endif + + // Store GLSL version string so we can refer to it later in case we recreate shaders. + // Note: GLSL version is NOT the same as GL version. Leave this to NULL if unsure. + if (glsl_version == NULL) + { +#if defined(IMGUI_IMPL_OPENGL_ES2) + glsl_version = "#version 100"; +#elif defined(IMGUI_IMPL_OPENGL_ES3) + glsl_version = "#version 300 es"; +#elif defined(__APPLE__) + glsl_version = "#version 150"; +#else + glsl_version = "#version 130"; +#endif + } + IM_ASSERT((int)strlen(glsl_version) + 2 < IM_ARRAYSIZE(bd->GlslVersionString)); + strcpy(bd->GlslVersionString, glsl_version); + strcat(bd->GlslVersionString, "\n"); + + // Make an arbitrary GL call (we don't actually need the result) + // IF YOU GET A CRASH HERE: it probably means the OpenGL function loader didn't do its job. Let us know! + GLint current_texture; + glGetIntegerv(GL_TEXTURE_BINDING_2D, ¤t_texture); + + // Detect extensions we support + bd->HasClipOrigin = (bd->GlVersion >= 450); +#ifdef IMGUI_IMPL_OPENGL_MAY_HAVE_EXTENSIONS + GLint num_extensions = 0; + glGetIntegerv(GL_NUM_EXTENSIONS, &num_extensions); + for (GLint i = 0; i < num_extensions; i++) + { + const char* extension = (const char*)glGetStringi(GL_EXTENSIONS, i); + if (extension != NULL && strcmp(extension, "GL_ARB_clip_control") == 0) + bd->HasClipOrigin = true; + } +#endif + + return true; +} + +void ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_Shutdown() +{ + ImGuiIO& io = ImGui::GetIO(); + ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_Data* bd = ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_GetBackendData(); + + ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_DestroyDeviceObjects(); + io.BackendRendererName = NULL; + io.BackendRendererUserData = NULL; + IM_DELETE(bd); +} + +void ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_NewFrame() +{ + ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_Data* bd = ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_GetBackendData(); + IM_ASSERT(bd != NULL && "Did you call ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_Init()?"); + + if (!bd->ShaderHandle) + ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_CreateDeviceObjects(); +} + +static void ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_SetupRenderState(ImDrawData* draw_data, int fb_width, int fb_height, GLuint vertex_array_object) +{ + ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_Data* bd = ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_GetBackendData(); + + // Setup render state: alpha-blending enabled, no face culling, no depth testing, scissor enabled, polygon fill + glEnable(GL_BLEND); + glBlendEquation(GL_FUNC_ADD); + glBlendFuncSeparate(GL_SRC_ALPHA, GL_ONE_MINUS_SRC_ALPHA, GL_ONE, GL_ONE_MINUS_SRC_ALPHA); + glDisable(GL_CULL_FACE); + glDisable(GL_DEPTH_TEST); + glDisable(GL_STENCIL_TEST); + glEnable(GL_SCISSOR_TEST); +#ifdef IMGUI_IMPL_OPENGL_MAY_HAVE_PRIMITIVE_RESTART + if (bd->GlVersion >= 310) + glDisable(GL_PRIMITIVE_RESTART); +#endif +#ifdef IMGUI_IMPL_HAS_POLYGON_MODE + glPolygonMode(GL_FRONT_AND_BACK, GL_FILL); +#endif + + // Support for GL 4.5 rarely used glClipControl(GL_UPPER_LEFT) +#if defined(GL_CLIP_ORIGIN) + bool clip_origin_lower_left = true; + if (bd->HasClipOrigin) + { + GLenum current_clip_origin = 0; glGetIntegerv(GL_CLIP_ORIGIN, (GLint*)¤t_clip_origin); + if (current_clip_origin == GL_UPPER_LEFT) + clip_origin_lower_left = false; + } +#endif + + // Setup viewport, orthographic projection matrix + // Our visible imgui space lies from draw_data->DisplayPos (top left) to draw_data->DisplayPos+data_data->DisplaySize (bottom right). DisplayPos is (0,0) for single viewport apps. + glViewport(0, 0, (GLsizei)fb_width, (GLsizei)fb_height); + float L = draw_data->DisplayPos.x; + float R = draw_data->DisplayPos.x + draw_data->DisplaySize.x; + float T = draw_data->DisplayPos.y; + float B = draw_data->DisplayPos.y + draw_data->DisplaySize.y; +#if defined(GL_CLIP_ORIGIN) + if (!clip_origin_lower_left) { float tmp = T; T = B; B = tmp; } // Swap top and bottom if origin is upper left +#endif + const float ortho_projection[4][4] = + { + { 2.0f/(R-L), 0.0f, 0.0f, 0.0f }, + { 0.0f, 2.0f/(T-B), 0.0f, 0.0f }, + { 0.0f, 0.0f, -1.0f, 0.0f }, + { (R+L)/(L-R), (T+B)/(B-T), 0.0f, 1.0f }, + }; + glUseProgram(bd->ShaderHandle); + glUniform1i(bd->AttribLocationTex, 0); + glUniformMatrix4fv(bd->AttribLocationProjMtx, 1, GL_FALSE, &ortho_projection[0][0]); + +#ifdef IMGUI_IMPL_OPENGL_MAY_HAVE_BIND_SAMPLER + if (bd->GlVersion >= 330) + glBindSampler(0, 0); // We use combined texture/sampler state. Applications using GL 3.3 may set that otherwise. +#endif + + (void)vertex_array_object; +#ifdef IMGUI_IMPL_OPENGL_USE_VERTEX_ARRAY + glBindVertexArray(vertex_array_object); +#endif + + // Bind vertex/index buffers and setup attributes for ImDrawVert + glBindBuffer(GL_ARRAY_BUFFER, bd->VboHandle); + glBindBuffer(GL_ELEMENT_ARRAY_BUFFER, bd->ElementsHandle); + glEnableVertexAttribArray(bd->AttribLocationVtxPos); + glEnableVertexAttribArray(bd->AttribLocationVtxUV); + glEnableVertexAttribArray(bd->AttribLocationVtxColor); + glVertexAttribPointer(bd->AttribLocationVtxPos, 2, GL_FLOAT, GL_FALSE, sizeof(ImDrawVert), (GLvoid*)IM_OFFSETOF(ImDrawVert, pos)); + glVertexAttribPointer(bd->AttribLocationVtxUV, 2, GL_FLOAT, GL_FALSE, sizeof(ImDrawVert), (GLvoid*)IM_OFFSETOF(ImDrawVert, uv)); + glVertexAttribPointer(bd->AttribLocationVtxColor, 4, GL_UNSIGNED_BYTE, GL_TRUE, sizeof(ImDrawVert), (GLvoid*)IM_OFFSETOF(ImDrawVert, col)); +} + +// OpenGL3 Render function. +// Note that this implementation is little overcomplicated because we are saving/setting up/restoring every OpenGL state explicitly. +// This is in order to be able to run within an OpenGL engine that doesn't do so. +void ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_RenderDrawData(ImDrawData* draw_data) +{ + // Avoid rendering when minimized, scale coordinates for retina displays (screen coordinates != framebuffer coordinates) + int fb_width = (int)(draw_data->DisplaySize.x * draw_data->FramebufferScale.x); + int fb_height = (int)(draw_data->DisplaySize.y * draw_data->FramebufferScale.y); + if (fb_width <= 0 || fb_height <= 0) + return; + + ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_Data* bd = ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_GetBackendData(); + + // Backup GL state + GLenum last_active_texture; glGetIntegerv(GL_ACTIVE_TEXTURE, (GLint*)&last_active_texture); + glActiveTexture(GL_TEXTURE0); + GLuint last_program; glGetIntegerv(GL_CURRENT_PROGRAM, (GLint*)&last_program); + GLuint last_texture; glGetIntegerv(GL_TEXTURE_BINDING_2D, (GLint*)&last_texture); +#ifdef IMGUI_IMPL_OPENGL_MAY_HAVE_BIND_SAMPLER + GLuint last_sampler; if (bd->GlVersion >= 330) { glGetIntegerv(GL_SAMPLER_BINDING, (GLint*)&last_sampler); } else { last_sampler = 0; } +#endif + GLuint last_array_buffer; glGetIntegerv(GL_ARRAY_BUFFER_BINDING, (GLint*)&last_array_buffer); +#ifdef IMGUI_IMPL_OPENGL_USE_VERTEX_ARRAY + GLuint last_vertex_array_object; glGetIntegerv(GL_VERTEX_ARRAY_BINDING, (GLint*)&last_vertex_array_object); +#endif +#ifdef IMGUI_IMPL_HAS_POLYGON_MODE + GLint last_polygon_mode[2]; glGetIntegerv(GL_POLYGON_MODE, last_polygon_mode); +#endif + GLint last_viewport[4]; glGetIntegerv(GL_VIEWPORT, last_viewport); + GLint last_scissor_box[4]; glGetIntegerv(GL_SCISSOR_BOX, last_scissor_box); + GLenum last_blend_src_rgb; glGetIntegerv(GL_BLEND_SRC_RGB, (GLint*)&last_blend_src_rgb); + GLenum last_blend_dst_rgb; glGetIntegerv(GL_BLEND_DST_RGB, (GLint*)&last_blend_dst_rgb); + GLenum last_blend_src_alpha; glGetIntegerv(GL_BLEND_SRC_ALPHA, (GLint*)&last_blend_src_alpha); + GLenum last_blend_dst_alpha; glGetIntegerv(GL_BLEND_DST_ALPHA, (GLint*)&last_blend_dst_alpha); + GLenum last_blend_equation_rgb; glGetIntegerv(GL_BLEND_EQUATION_RGB, (GLint*)&last_blend_equation_rgb); + GLenum last_blend_equation_alpha; glGetIntegerv(GL_BLEND_EQUATION_ALPHA, (GLint*)&last_blend_equation_alpha); + GLboolean last_enable_blend = glIsEnabled(GL_BLEND); + GLboolean last_enable_cull_face = glIsEnabled(GL_CULL_FACE); + GLboolean last_enable_depth_test = glIsEnabled(GL_DEPTH_TEST); + GLboolean last_enable_stencil_test = glIsEnabled(GL_STENCIL_TEST); + GLboolean last_enable_scissor_test = glIsEnabled(GL_SCISSOR_TEST); +#ifdef IMGUI_IMPL_OPENGL_MAY_HAVE_PRIMITIVE_RESTART + GLboolean last_enable_primitive_restart = (bd->GlVersion >= 310) ? glIsEnabled(GL_PRIMITIVE_RESTART) : GL_FALSE; +#endif + + // Setup desired GL state + // Recreate the VAO every time (this is to easily allow multiple GL contexts to be rendered to. VAO are not shared among GL contexts) + // The renderer would actually work without any VAO bound, but then our VertexAttrib calls would overwrite the default one currently bound. + GLuint vertex_array_object = 0; +#ifdef IMGUI_IMPL_OPENGL_USE_VERTEX_ARRAY + glGenVertexArrays(1, &vertex_array_object); +#endif + ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_SetupRenderState(draw_data, fb_width, fb_height, vertex_array_object); + + // Will project scissor/clipping rectangles into framebuffer space + ImVec2 clip_off = draw_data->DisplayPos; // (0,0) unless using multi-viewports + ImVec2 clip_scale = draw_data->FramebufferScale; // (1,1) unless using retina display which are often (2,2) + + // Render command lists + for (int n = 0; n < draw_data->CmdListsCount; n++) + { + const ImDrawList* cmd_list = draw_data->CmdLists[n]; + + // Upload vertex/index buffers + glBufferData(GL_ARRAY_BUFFER, (GLsizeiptr)cmd_list->VtxBuffer.Size * (int)sizeof(ImDrawVert), (const GLvoid*)cmd_list->VtxBuffer.Data, GL_STREAM_DRAW); + glBufferData(GL_ELEMENT_ARRAY_BUFFER, (GLsizeiptr)cmd_list->IdxBuffer.Size * (int)sizeof(ImDrawIdx), (const GLvoid*)cmd_list->IdxBuffer.Data, GL_STREAM_DRAW); + + for (int cmd_i = 0; cmd_i < cmd_list->CmdBuffer.Size; cmd_i++) + { + const ImDrawCmd* pcmd = &cmd_list->CmdBuffer[cmd_i]; + if (pcmd->UserCallback != NULL) + { + // User callback, registered via ImDrawList::AddCallback() + // (ImDrawCallback_ResetRenderState is a special callback value used by the user to request the renderer to reset render state.) + if (pcmd->UserCallback == ImDrawCallback_ResetRenderState) + ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_SetupRenderState(draw_data, fb_width, fb_height, vertex_array_object); + else + pcmd->UserCallback(cmd_list, pcmd); + } + else + { + // Project scissor/clipping rectangles into framebuffer space + ImVec4 clip_rect; + clip_rect.x = (pcmd->ClipRect.x - clip_off.x) * clip_scale.x; + clip_rect.y = (pcmd->ClipRect.y - clip_off.y) * clip_scale.y; + clip_rect.z = (pcmd->ClipRect.z - clip_off.x) * clip_scale.x; + clip_rect.w = (pcmd->ClipRect.w - clip_off.y) * clip_scale.y; + + if (clip_rect.x < fb_width && clip_rect.y < fb_height && clip_rect.z >= 0.0f && clip_rect.w >= 0.0f) + { + // Apply scissor/clipping rectangle + glScissor((int)clip_rect.x, (int)(fb_height - clip_rect.w), (int)(clip_rect.z - clip_rect.x), (int)(clip_rect.w - clip_rect.y)); + + // Bind texture, Draw + glBindTexture(GL_TEXTURE_2D, (GLuint)(intptr_t)pcmd->GetTexID()); +#ifdef IMGUI_IMPL_OPENGL_MAY_HAVE_VTX_OFFSET + if (bd->GlVersion >= 320) + glDrawElementsBaseVertex(GL_TRIANGLES, (GLsizei)pcmd->ElemCount, sizeof(ImDrawIdx) == 2 ? GL_UNSIGNED_SHORT : GL_UNSIGNED_INT, (void*)(intptr_t)(pcmd->IdxOffset * sizeof(ImDrawIdx)), (GLint)pcmd->VtxOffset); + else +#endif + glDrawElements(GL_TRIANGLES, (GLsizei)pcmd->ElemCount, sizeof(ImDrawIdx) == 2 ? GL_UNSIGNED_SHORT : GL_UNSIGNED_INT, (void*)(intptr_t)(pcmd->IdxOffset * sizeof(ImDrawIdx))); + } + } + } + } + + // Destroy the temporary VAO +#ifdef IMGUI_IMPL_OPENGL_USE_VERTEX_ARRAY + glDeleteVertexArrays(1, &vertex_array_object); +#endif + + // Restore modified GL state + glUseProgram(last_program); + glBindTexture(GL_TEXTURE_2D, last_texture); +#ifdef IMGUI_IMPL_OPENGL_MAY_HAVE_BIND_SAMPLER + if (bd->GlVersion >= 330) + glBindSampler(0, last_sampler); +#endif + glActiveTexture(last_active_texture); +#ifdef IMGUI_IMPL_OPENGL_USE_VERTEX_ARRAY + glBindVertexArray(last_vertex_array_object); +#endif + glBindBuffer(GL_ARRAY_BUFFER, last_array_buffer); + glBlendEquationSeparate(last_blend_equation_rgb, last_blend_equation_alpha); + glBlendFuncSeparate(last_blend_src_rgb, last_blend_dst_rgb, last_blend_src_alpha, last_blend_dst_alpha); + if (last_enable_blend) glEnable(GL_BLEND); else glDisable(GL_BLEND); + if (last_enable_cull_face) glEnable(GL_CULL_FACE); else glDisable(GL_CULL_FACE); + if (last_enable_depth_test) glEnable(GL_DEPTH_TEST); else glDisable(GL_DEPTH_TEST); + if (last_enable_stencil_test) glEnable(GL_STENCIL_TEST); else glDisable(GL_STENCIL_TEST); + if (last_enable_scissor_test) glEnable(GL_SCISSOR_TEST); else glDisable(GL_SCISSOR_TEST); +#ifdef IMGUI_IMPL_OPENGL_MAY_HAVE_PRIMITIVE_RESTART + if (bd->GlVersion >= 310) { if (last_enable_primitive_restart) glEnable(GL_PRIMITIVE_RESTART); else glDisable(GL_PRIMITIVE_RESTART); } +#endif + +#ifdef IMGUI_IMPL_HAS_POLYGON_MODE + glPolygonMode(GL_FRONT_AND_BACK, (GLenum)last_polygon_mode[0]); +#endif + glViewport(last_viewport[0], last_viewport[1], (GLsizei)last_viewport[2], (GLsizei)last_viewport[3]); + glScissor(last_scissor_box[0], last_scissor_box[1], (GLsizei)last_scissor_box[2], (GLsizei)last_scissor_box[3]); + (void)bd; // Not all compilation paths use this +} + +bool ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_CreateFontsTexture() +{ + ImGuiIO& io = ImGui::GetIO(); + ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_Data* bd = ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_GetBackendData(); + + // Build texture atlas + unsigned char* pixels; + int width, height; + io.Fonts->GetTexDataAsRGBA32(&pixels, &width, &height); // Load as RGBA 32-bit (75% of the memory is wasted, but default font is so small) because it is more likely to be compatible with user's existing shaders. If your ImTextureId represent a higher-level concept than just a GL texture id, consider calling GetTexDataAsAlpha8() instead to save on GPU memory. + + // Upload texture to graphics system + GLint last_texture; + glGetIntegerv(GL_TEXTURE_BINDING_2D, &last_texture); + glGenTextures(1, &bd->FontTexture); + glBindTexture(GL_TEXTURE_2D, bd->FontTexture); + glTexParameteri(GL_TEXTURE_2D, GL_TEXTURE_MIN_FILTER, GL_LINEAR); + glTexParameteri(GL_TEXTURE_2D, GL_TEXTURE_MAG_FILTER, GL_LINEAR); +#ifdef GL_UNPACK_ROW_LENGTH // Not on WebGL/ES + glPixelStorei(GL_UNPACK_ROW_LENGTH, 0); +#endif + glTexImage2D(GL_TEXTURE_2D, 0, GL_RGBA, width, height, 0, GL_RGBA, GL_UNSIGNED_BYTE, pixels); + + // Store our identifier + io.Fonts->SetTexID((ImTextureID)(intptr_t)bd->FontTexture); + + // Restore state + glBindTexture(GL_TEXTURE_2D, last_texture); + + return true; +} + +void ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_DestroyFontsTexture() +{ + ImGuiIO& io = ImGui::GetIO(); + ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_Data* bd = ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_GetBackendData(); + if (bd->FontTexture) + { + glDeleteTextures(1, &bd->FontTexture); + io.Fonts->SetTexID(0); + bd->FontTexture = 0; + } +} + +// If you get an error please report on github. You may try different GL context version or GLSL version. See GL<>GLSL version table at the top of this file. +static bool CheckShader(GLuint handle, const char* desc) +{ + ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_Data* bd = ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_GetBackendData(); + GLint status = 0, log_length = 0; + glGetShaderiv(handle, GL_COMPILE_STATUS, &status); + glGetShaderiv(handle, GL_INFO_LOG_LENGTH, &log_length); + if ((GLboolean)status == GL_FALSE) + fprintf(stderr, "ERROR: ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_CreateDeviceObjects: failed to compile %s! With GLSL: %s\n", desc, bd->GlslVersionString); + if (log_length > 1) + { + ImVector buf; + buf.resize((int)(log_length + 1)); + glGetShaderInfoLog(handle, log_length, NULL, (GLchar*)buf.begin()); + fprintf(stderr, "%s\n", buf.begin()); + } + return (GLboolean)status == GL_TRUE; +} + +// If you get an error please report on GitHub. You may try different GL context version or GLSL version. +static bool CheckProgram(GLuint handle, const char* desc) +{ + ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_Data* bd = ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_GetBackendData(); + GLint status = 0, log_length = 0; + glGetProgramiv(handle, GL_LINK_STATUS, &status); + glGetProgramiv(handle, GL_INFO_LOG_LENGTH, &log_length); + if ((GLboolean)status == GL_FALSE) + fprintf(stderr, "ERROR: ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_CreateDeviceObjects: failed to link %s! With GLSL %s\n", desc, bd->GlslVersionString); + if (log_length > 1) + { + ImVector buf; + buf.resize((int)(log_length + 1)); + glGetProgramInfoLog(handle, log_length, NULL, (GLchar*)buf.begin()); + fprintf(stderr, "%s\n", buf.begin()); + } + return (GLboolean)status == GL_TRUE; +} + +bool ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_CreateDeviceObjects() +{ + ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_Data* bd = ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_GetBackendData(); + + // Backup GL state + GLint last_texture, last_array_buffer; + glGetIntegerv(GL_TEXTURE_BINDING_2D, &last_texture); + glGetIntegerv(GL_ARRAY_BUFFER_BINDING, &last_array_buffer); +#ifdef IMGUI_IMPL_OPENGL_USE_VERTEX_ARRAY + GLint last_vertex_array; + glGetIntegerv(GL_VERTEX_ARRAY_BINDING, &last_vertex_array); +#endif + + // Parse GLSL version string + int glsl_version = 130; + sscanf(bd->GlslVersionString, "#version %d", &glsl_version); + + const GLchar* vertex_shader_glsl_120 = + "uniform mat4 ProjMtx;\n" + "attribute vec2 Position;\n" + "attribute vec2 UV;\n" + "attribute vec4 Color;\n" + "varying vec2 Frag_UV;\n" + "varying vec4 Frag_Color;\n" + "void main()\n" + "{\n" + " Frag_UV = UV;\n" + " Frag_Color = Color;\n" + " gl_Position = ProjMtx * vec4(Position.xy,0,1);\n" + "}\n"; + + const GLchar* vertex_shader_glsl_130 = + "uniform mat4 ProjMtx;\n" + "in vec2 Position;\n" + "in vec2 UV;\n" + "in vec4 Color;\n" + "out vec2 Frag_UV;\n" + "out vec4 Frag_Color;\n" + "void main()\n" + "{\n" + " Frag_UV = UV;\n" + " Frag_Color = Color;\n" + " gl_Position = ProjMtx * vec4(Position.xy,0,1);\n" + "}\n"; + + const GLchar* vertex_shader_glsl_300_es = + "precision highp float;\n" + "layout (location = 0) in vec2 Position;\n" + "layout (location = 1) in vec2 UV;\n" + "layout (location = 2) in vec4 Color;\n" + "uniform mat4 ProjMtx;\n" + "out vec2 Frag_UV;\n" + "out vec4 Frag_Color;\n" + "void main()\n" + "{\n" + " Frag_UV = UV;\n" + " Frag_Color = Color;\n" + " gl_Position = ProjMtx * vec4(Position.xy,0,1);\n" + "}\n"; + + const GLchar* vertex_shader_glsl_410_core = + "layout (location = 0) in vec2 Position;\n" + "layout (location = 1) in vec2 UV;\n" + "layout (location = 2) in vec4 Color;\n" + "uniform mat4 ProjMtx;\n" + "out vec2 Frag_UV;\n" + "out vec4 Frag_Color;\n" + "void main()\n" + "{\n" + " Frag_UV = UV;\n" + " Frag_Color = Color;\n" + " gl_Position = ProjMtx * vec4(Position.xy,0,1);\n" + "}\n"; + + const GLchar* fragment_shader_glsl_120 = + "#ifdef GL_ES\n" + " precision mediump float;\n" + "#endif\n" + "uniform sampler2D Texture;\n" + "varying vec2 Frag_UV;\n" + "varying vec4 Frag_Color;\n" + "void main()\n" + "{\n" + " gl_FragColor = Frag_Color * texture2D(Texture, Frag_UV.st);\n" + "}\n"; + + const GLchar* fragment_shader_glsl_130 = + "uniform sampler2D Texture;\n" + "in vec2 Frag_UV;\n" + "in vec4 Frag_Color;\n" + "out vec4 Out_Color;\n" + "void main()\n" + "{\n" + " Out_Color = Frag_Color * texture(Texture, Frag_UV.st);\n" + "}\n"; + + const GLchar* fragment_shader_glsl_300_es = + "precision mediump float;\n" + "uniform sampler2D Texture;\n" + "in vec2 Frag_UV;\n" + "in vec4 Frag_Color;\n" + "layout (location = 0) out vec4 Out_Color;\n" + "void main()\n" + "{\n" + " Out_Color = Frag_Color * texture(Texture, Frag_UV.st);\n" + "}\n"; + + const GLchar* fragment_shader_glsl_410_core = + "in vec2 Frag_UV;\n" + "in vec4 Frag_Color;\n" + "uniform sampler2D Texture;\n" + "layout (location = 0) out vec4 Out_Color;\n" + "void main()\n" + "{\n" + " Out_Color = Frag_Color * texture(Texture, Frag_UV.st);\n" + "}\n"; + + // Select shaders matching our GLSL versions + const GLchar* vertex_shader = NULL; + const GLchar* fragment_shader = NULL; + if (glsl_version < 130) + { + vertex_shader = vertex_shader_glsl_120; + fragment_shader = fragment_shader_glsl_120; + } + else if (glsl_version >= 410) + { + vertex_shader = vertex_shader_glsl_410_core; + fragment_shader = fragment_shader_glsl_410_core; + } + else if (glsl_version == 300) + { + vertex_shader = vertex_shader_glsl_300_es; + fragment_shader = fragment_shader_glsl_300_es; + } + else + { + vertex_shader = vertex_shader_glsl_130; + fragment_shader = fragment_shader_glsl_130; + } + + // Create shaders + const GLchar* vertex_shader_with_version[2] = { bd->GlslVersionString, vertex_shader }; + GLuint vert_handle = glCreateShader(GL_VERTEX_SHADER); + glShaderSource(vert_handle, 2, vertex_shader_with_version, NULL); + glCompileShader(vert_handle); + CheckShader(vert_handle, "vertex shader"); + + const GLchar* fragment_shader_with_version[2] = { bd->GlslVersionString, fragment_shader }; + GLuint frag_handle = glCreateShader(GL_FRAGMENT_SHADER); + glShaderSource(frag_handle, 2, fragment_shader_with_version, NULL); + glCompileShader(frag_handle); + CheckShader(frag_handle, "fragment shader"); + + // Link + bd->ShaderHandle = glCreateProgram(); + glAttachShader(bd->ShaderHandle, vert_handle); + glAttachShader(bd->ShaderHandle, frag_handle); + glLinkProgram(bd->ShaderHandle); + CheckProgram(bd->ShaderHandle, "shader program"); + + glDetachShader(bd->ShaderHandle, vert_handle); + glDetachShader(bd->ShaderHandle, frag_handle); + glDeleteShader(vert_handle); + glDeleteShader(frag_handle); + + bd->AttribLocationTex = glGetUniformLocation(bd->ShaderHandle, "Texture"); + bd->AttribLocationProjMtx = glGetUniformLocation(bd->ShaderHandle, "ProjMtx"); + bd->AttribLocationVtxPos = (GLuint)glGetAttribLocation(bd->ShaderHandle, "Position"); + bd->AttribLocationVtxUV = (GLuint)glGetAttribLocation(bd->ShaderHandle, "UV"); + bd->AttribLocationVtxColor = (GLuint)glGetAttribLocation(bd->ShaderHandle, "Color"); + + // Create buffers + glGenBuffers(1, &bd->VboHandle); + glGenBuffers(1, &bd->ElementsHandle); + + ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_CreateFontsTexture(); + + // Restore modified GL state + glBindTexture(GL_TEXTURE_2D, last_texture); + glBindBuffer(GL_ARRAY_BUFFER, last_array_buffer); +#ifdef IMGUI_IMPL_OPENGL_USE_VERTEX_ARRAY + glBindVertexArray(last_vertex_array); +#endif + + return true; +} + +void ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_DestroyDeviceObjects() +{ + ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_Data* bd = ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_GetBackendData(); + if (bd->VboHandle) { glDeleteBuffers(1, &bd->VboHandle); bd->VboHandle = 0; } + if (bd->ElementsHandle) { glDeleteBuffers(1, &bd->ElementsHandle); bd->ElementsHandle = 0; } + if (bd->ShaderHandle) { glDeleteProgram(bd->ShaderHandle); bd->ShaderHandle = 0; } + ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_DestroyFontsTexture(); +} diff --git a/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/imgui-1.84.2/imgui_impl_opengl3.h b/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/imgui-1.84.2/imgui_impl_opengl3.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000..b1fb49c --- /dev/null +++ b/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/imgui-1.84.2/imgui_impl_opengl3.h @@ -0,0 +1,55 @@ +// dear imgui: Renderer Backend for modern OpenGL with shaders / programmatic pipeline +// - Desktop GL: 2.x 3.x 4.x +// - Embedded GL: ES 2.0 (WebGL 1.0), ES 3.0 (WebGL 2.0) +// This needs to be used along with a Platform Backend (e.g. GLFW, SDL, Win32, custom..) + +// Implemented features: +// [X] Renderer: User texture binding. Use 'GLuint' OpenGL texture identifier as void*/ImTextureID. Read the FAQ about ImTextureID! +// [x] Renderer: Desktop GL only: Support for large meshes (64k+ vertices) with 16-bit indices. + +// You can use unmodified imgui_impl_* files in your project. See examples/ folder for examples of using this. +// Prefer including the entire imgui/ repository into your project (either as a copy or as a submodule), and only build the backends you need. +// If you are new to Dear ImGui, read documentation from the docs/ folder + read the top of imgui.cpp. +// Read online: https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/tree/master/docs + +// About GLSL version: +// The 'glsl_version' initialization parameter should be NULL (default) or a "#version XXX" string. +// On computer platform the GLSL version default to "#version 130". On OpenGL ES 3 platform it defaults to "#version 300 es" +// Only override if your GL version doesn't handle this GLSL version. See GLSL version table at the top of imgui_impl_opengl3.cpp. + +#pragma once +#include "imgui.h" // IMGUI_IMPL_API + +// Backend API +IMGUI_IMPL_API bool ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_Init(const char* glsl_version = NULL); +IMGUI_IMPL_API void ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_Shutdown(); +IMGUI_IMPL_API void ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_NewFrame(); +IMGUI_IMPL_API void ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_RenderDrawData(ImDrawData* draw_data); + +// (Optional) Called by Init/NewFrame/Shutdown +IMGUI_IMPL_API bool ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_CreateFontsTexture(); +IMGUI_IMPL_API void ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_DestroyFontsTexture(); +IMGUI_IMPL_API bool ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_CreateDeviceObjects(); +IMGUI_IMPL_API void ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_DestroyDeviceObjects(); + +// Specific OpenGL ES versions +//#define IMGUI_IMPL_OPENGL_ES2 // Auto-detected on Emscripten +//#define IMGUI_IMPL_OPENGL_ES3 // Auto-detected on iOS/Android + +// You can explicitly select GLES2 or GLES3 API by using one of the '#define IMGUI_IMPL_OPENGL_LOADER_XXX' in imconfig.h or compiler command-line. +#if !defined(IMGUI_IMPL_OPENGL_ES2) \ + && !defined(IMGUI_IMPL_OPENGL_ES3) + +// Try to detect GLES on matching platforms +#if defined(__APPLE__) +#include "TargetConditionals.h" +#endif +#if (defined(__APPLE__) && (TARGET_OS_IOS || TARGET_OS_TV)) || (defined(__ANDROID__)) +#define IMGUI_IMPL_OPENGL_ES3 // iOS, Android -> GL ES 3, "#version 300 es" +#elif defined(__EMSCRIPTEN__) +#define IMGUI_IMPL_OPENGL_ES2 // Emscripten -> GL ES 2, "#version 100" +#else +// Otherwise imgui_impl_opengl3_loader.h will be used. +#endif + +#endif diff --git a/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/imgui-1.84.2/imgui_impl_opengl3_loader.h b/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/imgui-1.84.2/imgui_impl_opengl3_loader.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000..021921e --- /dev/null +++ b/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/imgui-1.84.2/imgui_impl_opengl3_loader.h @@ -0,0 +1,730 @@ +/* + * This file was generated with gl3w_gen.py, part of imgl3w + * (hosted at https://github.com/dearimgui/gl3w_stripped) + * + * This is free and unencumbered software released into the public domain. + * + * Anyone is free to copy, modify, publish, use, compile, sell, or + * distribute this software, either in source code form or as a compiled + * binary, for any purpose, commercial or non-commercial, and by any + * means. + * + * In jurisdictions that recognize copyright laws, the author or authors + * of this software dedicate any and all copyright interest in the + * software to the public domain. We make this dedication for the benefit + * of the public at large and to the detriment of our heirs and + * successors. We intend this dedication to be an overt act of + * relinquishment in perpetuity of all present and future rights to this + * software under copyright law. + * + * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, + * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF + * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. + * IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR + * OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, + * ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR + * OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. + */ + +// We embed our own OpenGL loader to not require user to provide their own or to have to use ours, which proved to be endless problems for users. +// Our loader is custom-generated, based on gl3w but automatically filtered to only include enums/functions that we use in this source file. +// Regenerate with: python gl3w_gen.py --imgui-dir /path/to/imgui/ +// see https://github.com/dearimgui/gl3w_stripped for more info. +#ifndef __gl3w_h_ +#define __gl3w_h_ + +// Adapted from KHR/khrplatform.h to avoid including entire file. +typedef float khronos_float_t; +typedef signed char khronos_int8_t; +typedef unsigned char khronos_uint8_t; +typedef signed short int khronos_int16_t; +typedef unsigned short int khronos_uint16_t; +#ifdef _WIN64 +typedef signed long long int khronos_intptr_t; +typedef signed long long int khronos_ssize_t; +#else +typedef signed long int khronos_intptr_t; +typedef signed long int khronos_ssize_t; +#endif + +#if defined(_MSC_VER) && !defined(__clang__) +typedef signed __int64 khronos_int64_t; +typedef unsigned __int64 khronos_uint64_t; +#elif (defined(__clang__) || defined(__GNUC__)) && (__cplusplus < 201100) +#include +typedef int64_t khronos_int64_t; +typedef uint64_t khronos_uint64_t; +#else +typedef signed long long khronos_int64_t; +typedef unsigned long long khronos_uint64_t; +#endif + +#ifndef __gl_glcorearb_h_ +#define __gl_glcorearb_h_ 1 +#ifdef __cplusplus +extern "C" { +#endif +/* +** Copyright 2013-2020 The Khronos Group Inc. +** SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT +** +** This header is generated from the Khronos OpenGL / OpenGL ES XML +** API Registry. The current version of the Registry, generator scripts +** used to make the header, and the header can be found at +** https://github.com/KhronosGroup/OpenGL-Registry +*/ +#if defined(_WIN32) && !defined(APIENTRY) && !defined(__CYGWIN__) && !defined(__SCITECH_SNAP__) +#ifndef WIN32_LEAN_AND_MEAN +#define WIN32_LEAN_AND_MEAN 1 +#endif +#include +#endif +#ifndef APIENTRY +#define APIENTRY +#endif +#ifndef APIENTRYP +#define APIENTRYP APIENTRY * +#endif +#ifndef GLAPI +#define GLAPI extern +#endif +/* glcorearb.h is for use with OpenGL core profile implementations. +** It should should be placed in the same directory as gl.h and +** included as . +** +** glcorearb.h includes only APIs in the latest OpenGL core profile +** implementation together with APIs in newer ARB extensions which +** can be supported by the core profile. It does not, and never will +** include functionality removed from the core profile, such as +** fixed-function vertex and fragment processing. +** +** Do not #include both and either of or +** in the same source file. +*/ +/* Generated C header for: + * API: gl + * Profile: core + * Versions considered: .* + * Versions emitted: .* + * Default extensions included: glcore + * Additional extensions included: _nomatch_^ + * Extensions removed: _nomatch_^ + */ +#ifndef GL_VERSION_1_0 +typedef void GLvoid; +typedef unsigned int GLenum; + +typedef khronos_float_t GLfloat; +typedef int GLint; +typedef int GLsizei; +typedef unsigned int GLbitfield; +typedef double GLdouble; +typedef unsigned int GLuint; +typedef unsigned char GLboolean; +typedef khronos_uint8_t GLubyte; +#define GL_COLOR_BUFFER_BIT 0x00004000 +#define GL_FALSE 0 +#define GL_TRUE 1 +#define GL_TRIANGLES 0x0004 +#define GL_ONE 1 +#define GL_SRC_ALPHA 0x0302 +#define GL_ONE_MINUS_SRC_ALPHA 0x0303 +#define GL_FRONT_AND_BACK 0x0408 +#define GL_POLYGON_MODE 0x0B40 +#define GL_CULL_FACE 0x0B44 +#define GL_DEPTH_TEST 0x0B71 +#define GL_STENCIL_TEST 0x0B90 +#define GL_VIEWPORT 0x0BA2 +#define GL_BLEND 0x0BE2 +#define GL_SCISSOR_BOX 0x0C10 +#define GL_SCISSOR_TEST 0x0C11 +#define GL_UNPACK_ROW_LENGTH 0x0CF2 +#define GL_PACK_ALIGNMENT 0x0D05 +#define GL_TEXTURE_2D 0x0DE1 +#define GL_UNSIGNED_BYTE 0x1401 +#define GL_UNSIGNED_SHORT 0x1403 +#define GL_UNSIGNED_INT 0x1405 +#define GL_FLOAT 0x1406 +#define GL_RGBA 0x1908 +#define GL_FILL 0x1B02 +#define GL_VERSION 0x1F02 +#define GL_EXTENSIONS 0x1F03 +#define GL_LINEAR 0x2601 +#define GL_TEXTURE_MAG_FILTER 0x2800 +#define GL_TEXTURE_MIN_FILTER 0x2801 +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPOLYGONMODEPROC) (GLenum face, GLenum mode); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLSCISSORPROC) (GLint x, GLint y, GLsizei width, GLsizei height); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLTEXPARAMETERIPROC) (GLenum target, GLenum pname, GLint param); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLTEXIMAGE2DPROC) (GLenum target, GLint level, GLint internalformat, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLint border, GLenum format, GLenum type, const void *pixels); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLCLEARPROC) (GLbitfield mask); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLCLEARCOLORPROC) (GLfloat red, GLfloat green, GLfloat blue, GLfloat alpha); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDISABLEPROC) (GLenum cap); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLENABLEPROC) (GLenum cap); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLPIXELSTOREIPROC) (GLenum pname, GLint param); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLREADPIXELSPROC) (GLint x, GLint y, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLenum format, GLenum type, void *pixels); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETINTEGERVPROC) (GLenum pname, GLint *data); +typedef const GLubyte *(APIENTRYP PFNGLGETSTRINGPROC) (GLenum name); +typedef GLboolean (APIENTRYP PFNGLISENABLEDPROC) (GLenum cap); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVIEWPORTPROC) (GLint x, GLint y, GLsizei width, GLsizei height); +#ifdef GL_GLEXT_PROTOTYPES +GLAPI void APIENTRY glPolygonMode (GLenum face, GLenum mode); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glScissor (GLint x, GLint y, GLsizei width, GLsizei height); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glTexParameteri (GLenum target, GLenum pname, GLint param); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glTexImage2D (GLenum target, GLint level, GLint internalformat, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLint border, GLenum format, GLenum type, const void *pixels); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glClear (GLbitfield mask); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glClearColor (GLfloat red, GLfloat green, GLfloat blue, GLfloat alpha); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDisable (GLenum cap); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glEnable (GLenum cap); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glPixelStorei (GLenum pname, GLint param); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glReadPixels (GLint x, GLint y, GLsizei width, GLsizei height, GLenum format, GLenum type, void *pixels); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetIntegerv (GLenum pname, GLint *data); +GLAPI const GLubyte *APIENTRY glGetString (GLenum name); +GLAPI GLboolean APIENTRY glIsEnabled (GLenum cap); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glViewport (GLint x, GLint y, GLsizei width, GLsizei height); +#endif +#endif /* GL_VERSION_1_0 */ +#ifndef GL_VERSION_1_1 +typedef khronos_float_t GLclampf; +typedef double GLclampd; +#define GL_TEXTURE_BINDING_2D 0x8069 +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDRAWELEMENTSPROC) (GLenum mode, GLsizei count, GLenum type, const void *indices); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLBINDTEXTUREPROC) (GLenum target, GLuint texture); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDELETETEXTURESPROC) (GLsizei n, const GLuint *textures); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGENTEXTURESPROC) (GLsizei n, GLuint *textures); +#ifdef GL_GLEXT_PROTOTYPES +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDrawElements (GLenum mode, GLsizei count, GLenum type, const void *indices); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glBindTexture (GLenum target, GLuint texture); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDeleteTextures (GLsizei n, const GLuint *textures); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGenTextures (GLsizei n, GLuint *textures); +#endif +#endif /* GL_VERSION_1_1 */ +#ifndef GL_VERSION_1_3 +#define GL_TEXTURE0 0x84C0 +#define GL_ACTIVE_TEXTURE 0x84E0 +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLACTIVETEXTUREPROC) (GLenum texture); +#ifdef GL_GLEXT_PROTOTYPES +GLAPI void APIENTRY glActiveTexture (GLenum texture); +#endif +#endif /* GL_VERSION_1_3 */ +#ifndef GL_VERSION_1_4 +#define GL_BLEND_DST_RGB 0x80C8 +#define GL_BLEND_SRC_RGB 0x80C9 +#define GL_BLEND_DST_ALPHA 0x80CA +#define GL_BLEND_SRC_ALPHA 0x80CB +#define GL_FUNC_ADD 0x8006 +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLBLENDFUNCSEPARATEPROC) (GLenum sfactorRGB, GLenum dfactorRGB, GLenum sfactorAlpha, GLenum dfactorAlpha); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLBLENDEQUATIONPROC) (GLenum mode); +#ifdef GL_GLEXT_PROTOTYPES +GLAPI void APIENTRY glBlendFuncSeparate (GLenum sfactorRGB, GLenum dfactorRGB, GLenum sfactorAlpha, GLenum dfactorAlpha); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glBlendEquation (GLenum mode); +#endif +#endif /* GL_VERSION_1_4 */ +#ifndef GL_VERSION_1_5 +typedef khronos_ssize_t GLsizeiptr; +typedef khronos_intptr_t GLintptr; +#define GL_ARRAY_BUFFER 0x8892 +#define GL_ELEMENT_ARRAY_BUFFER 0x8893 +#define GL_ARRAY_BUFFER_BINDING 0x8894 +#define GL_STREAM_DRAW 0x88E0 +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLBINDBUFFERPROC) (GLenum target, GLuint buffer); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDELETEBUFFERSPROC) (GLsizei n, const GLuint *buffers); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGENBUFFERSPROC) (GLsizei n, GLuint *buffers); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLBUFFERDATAPROC) (GLenum target, GLsizeiptr size, const void *data, GLenum usage); +#ifdef GL_GLEXT_PROTOTYPES +GLAPI void APIENTRY glBindBuffer (GLenum target, GLuint buffer); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDeleteBuffers (GLsizei n, const GLuint *buffers); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGenBuffers (GLsizei n, GLuint *buffers); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glBufferData (GLenum target, GLsizeiptr size, const void *data, GLenum usage); +#endif +#endif /* GL_VERSION_1_5 */ +#ifndef GL_VERSION_2_0 +typedef char GLchar; +typedef khronos_int16_t GLshort; +typedef khronos_int8_t GLbyte; +typedef khronos_uint16_t GLushort; +#define GL_BLEND_EQUATION_RGB 0x8009 +#define GL_BLEND_EQUATION_ALPHA 0x883D +#define GL_FRAGMENT_SHADER 0x8B30 +#define GL_VERTEX_SHADER 0x8B31 +#define GL_COMPILE_STATUS 0x8B81 +#define GL_LINK_STATUS 0x8B82 +#define GL_INFO_LOG_LENGTH 0x8B84 +#define GL_CURRENT_PROGRAM 0x8B8D +#define GL_UPPER_LEFT 0x8CA2 +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLBLENDEQUATIONSEPARATEPROC) (GLenum modeRGB, GLenum modeAlpha); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLATTACHSHADERPROC) (GLuint program, GLuint shader); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLCOMPILESHADERPROC) (GLuint shader); +typedef GLuint (APIENTRYP PFNGLCREATEPROGRAMPROC) (void); +typedef GLuint (APIENTRYP PFNGLCREATESHADERPROC) (GLenum type); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDELETEPROGRAMPROC) (GLuint program); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDELETESHADERPROC) (GLuint shader); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDETACHSHADERPROC) (GLuint program, GLuint shader); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLENABLEVERTEXATTRIBARRAYPROC) (GLuint index); +typedef GLint (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETATTRIBLOCATIONPROC) (GLuint program, const GLchar *name); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETPROGRAMIVPROC) (GLuint program, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETPROGRAMINFOLOGPROC) (GLuint program, GLsizei bufSize, GLsizei *length, GLchar *infoLog); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETSHADERIVPROC) (GLuint shader, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETSHADERINFOLOGPROC) (GLuint shader, GLsizei bufSize, GLsizei *length, GLchar *infoLog); +typedef GLint (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETUNIFORMLOCATIONPROC) (GLuint program, const GLchar *name); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLLINKPROGRAMPROC) (GLuint program); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLSHADERSOURCEPROC) (GLuint shader, GLsizei count, const GLchar *const*string, const GLint *length); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLUSEPROGRAMPROC) (GLuint program); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLUNIFORM1IPROC) (GLint location, GLint v0); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX4FVPROC) (GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLfloat *value); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBPOINTERPROC) (GLuint index, GLint size, GLenum type, GLboolean normalized, GLsizei stride, const void *pointer); +#ifdef GL_GLEXT_PROTOTYPES +GLAPI void APIENTRY glBlendEquationSeparate (GLenum modeRGB, GLenum modeAlpha); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glAttachShader (GLuint program, GLuint shader); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glCompileShader (GLuint shader); +GLAPI GLuint APIENTRY glCreateProgram (void); +GLAPI GLuint APIENTRY glCreateShader (GLenum type); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDeleteProgram (GLuint program); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDeleteShader (GLuint shader); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDetachShader (GLuint program, GLuint shader); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glEnableVertexAttribArray (GLuint index); +GLAPI GLint APIENTRY glGetAttribLocation (GLuint program, const GLchar *name); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetProgramiv (GLuint program, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetProgramInfoLog (GLuint program, GLsizei bufSize, GLsizei *length, GLchar *infoLog); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetShaderiv (GLuint shader, GLenum pname, GLint *params); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGetShaderInfoLog (GLuint shader, GLsizei bufSize, GLsizei *length, GLchar *infoLog); +GLAPI GLint APIENTRY glGetUniformLocation (GLuint program, const GLchar *name); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glLinkProgram (GLuint program); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glShaderSource (GLuint shader, GLsizei count, const GLchar *const*string, const GLint *length); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glUseProgram (GLuint program); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glUniform1i (GLint location, GLint v0); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glUniformMatrix4fv (GLint location, GLsizei count, GLboolean transpose, const GLfloat *value); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glVertexAttribPointer (GLuint index, GLint size, GLenum type, GLboolean normalized, GLsizei stride, const void *pointer); +#endif +#endif /* GL_VERSION_2_0 */ +#ifndef GL_VERSION_3_0 +typedef khronos_uint16_t GLhalf; +#define GL_MAJOR_VERSION 0x821B +#define GL_MINOR_VERSION 0x821C +#define GL_NUM_EXTENSIONS 0x821D +#define GL_FRAMEBUFFER_SRGB 0x8DB9 +#define GL_VERTEX_ARRAY_BINDING 0x85B5 +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETBOOLEANI_VPROC) (GLenum target, GLuint index, GLboolean *data); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETINTEGERI_VPROC) (GLenum target, GLuint index, GLint *data); +typedef const GLubyte *(APIENTRYP PFNGLGETSTRINGIPROC) (GLenum name, GLuint index); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLBINDVERTEXARRAYPROC) (GLuint array); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDELETEVERTEXARRAYSPROC) (GLsizei n, const GLuint *arrays); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGENVERTEXARRAYSPROC) (GLsizei n, GLuint *arrays); +#ifdef GL_GLEXT_PROTOTYPES +GLAPI const GLubyte *APIENTRY glGetStringi (GLenum name, GLuint index); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glBindVertexArray (GLuint array); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDeleteVertexArrays (GLsizei n, const GLuint *arrays); +GLAPI void APIENTRY glGenVertexArrays (GLsizei n, GLuint *arrays); +#endif +#endif /* GL_VERSION_3_0 */ +#ifndef GL_VERSION_3_1 +#define GL_VERSION_3_1 1 +#define GL_PRIMITIVE_RESTART 0x8F9D +#endif /* GL_VERSION_3_1 */ +#ifndef GL_VERSION_3_2 +#define GL_VERSION_3_2 1 +typedef struct __GLsync *GLsync; +typedef khronos_uint64_t GLuint64; +typedef khronos_int64_t GLint64; +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLDRAWELEMENTSBASEVERTEXPROC) (GLenum mode, GLsizei count, GLenum type, const void *indices, GLint basevertex); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETINTEGER64I_VPROC) (GLenum target, GLuint index, GLint64 *data); +#ifdef GL_GLEXT_PROTOTYPES +GLAPI void APIENTRY glDrawElementsBaseVertex (GLenum mode, GLsizei count, GLenum type, const void *indices, GLint basevertex); +#endif +#endif /* GL_VERSION_3_2 */ +#ifndef GL_VERSION_3_3 +#define GL_VERSION_3_3 1 +#define GL_SAMPLER_BINDING 0x8919 +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLBINDSAMPLERPROC) (GLuint unit, GLuint sampler); +#ifdef GL_GLEXT_PROTOTYPES +GLAPI void APIENTRY glBindSampler (GLuint unit, GLuint sampler); +#endif +#endif /* GL_VERSION_3_3 */ +#ifndef GL_VERSION_4_1 +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETFLOATI_VPROC) (GLenum target, GLuint index, GLfloat *data); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETDOUBLEI_VPROC) (GLenum target, GLuint index, GLdouble *data); +#endif /* GL_VERSION_4_1 */ +#ifndef GL_VERSION_4_3 +typedef void (APIENTRY *GLDEBUGPROC)(GLenum source,GLenum type,GLuint id,GLenum severity,GLsizei length,const GLchar *message,const void *userParam); +#endif /* GL_VERSION_4_3 */ +#ifndef GL_VERSION_4_5 +#define GL_CLIP_ORIGIN 0x935C +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETTRANSFORMFEEDBACKI_VPROC) (GLuint xfb, GLenum pname, GLuint index, GLint *param); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETTRANSFORMFEEDBACKI64_VPROC) (GLuint xfb, GLenum pname, GLuint index, GLint64 *param); +#endif /* GL_VERSION_4_5 */ +#ifndef GL_ARB_bindless_texture +typedef khronos_uint64_t GLuint64EXT; +#endif /* GL_ARB_bindless_texture */ +#ifndef GL_ARB_cl_event +struct _cl_context; +struct _cl_event; +#endif /* GL_ARB_cl_event */ +#ifndef GL_ARB_clip_control +#define GL_ARB_clip_control 1 +#endif /* GL_ARB_clip_control */ +#ifndef GL_ARB_debug_output +typedef void (APIENTRY *GLDEBUGPROCARB)(GLenum source,GLenum type,GLuint id,GLenum severity,GLsizei length,const GLchar *message,const void *userParam); +#endif /* GL_ARB_debug_output */ +#ifndef GL_EXT_EGL_image_storage +typedef void *GLeglImageOES; +#endif /* GL_EXT_EGL_image_storage */ +#ifndef GL_EXT_direct_state_access +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETFLOATI_VEXTPROC) (GLenum pname, GLuint index, GLfloat *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETDOUBLEI_VEXTPROC) (GLenum pname, GLuint index, GLdouble *params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETPOINTERI_VEXTPROC) (GLenum pname, GLuint index, void **params); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETVERTEXARRAYINTEGERI_VEXTPROC) (GLuint vaobj, GLuint index, GLenum pname, GLint *param); +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETVERTEXARRAYPOINTERI_VEXTPROC) (GLuint vaobj, GLuint index, GLenum pname, void **param); +#endif /* GL_EXT_direct_state_access */ +#ifndef GL_NV_draw_vulkan_image +typedef void (APIENTRY *GLVULKANPROCNV)(void); +#endif /* GL_NV_draw_vulkan_image */ +#ifndef GL_NV_gpu_shader5 +typedef khronos_int64_t GLint64EXT; +#endif /* GL_NV_gpu_shader5 */ +#ifndef GL_NV_vertex_buffer_unified_memory +typedef void (APIENTRYP PFNGLGETINTEGERUI64I_VNVPROC) (GLenum value, GLuint index, GLuint64EXT *result); +#endif /* GL_NV_vertex_buffer_unified_memory */ +#ifdef __cplusplus +} +#endif +#endif + +#ifndef GL3W_API +#define GL3W_API +#endif + +#ifndef __gl_h_ +#define __gl_h_ +#endif + +#ifdef __cplusplus +extern "C" { +#endif + +#define GL3W_OK 0 +#define GL3W_ERROR_INIT -1 +#define GL3W_ERROR_LIBRARY_OPEN -2 +#define GL3W_ERROR_OPENGL_VERSION -3 + +typedef void (*GL3WglProc)(void); +typedef GL3WglProc (*GL3WGetProcAddressProc)(const char *proc); + +/* gl3w api */ +GL3W_API int imgl3wInit(void); +GL3W_API int imgl3wInit2(GL3WGetProcAddressProc proc); +GL3W_API int imgl3wIsSupported(int major, int minor); +GL3W_API GL3WglProc imgl3wGetProcAddress(const char *proc); + +/* gl3w internal state */ +union GL3WProcs { + GL3WglProc ptr[52]; + struct { + PFNGLACTIVETEXTUREPROC ActiveTexture; + PFNGLATTACHSHADERPROC AttachShader; + PFNGLBINDBUFFERPROC BindBuffer; + PFNGLBINDSAMPLERPROC BindSampler; + PFNGLBINDTEXTUREPROC BindTexture; + PFNGLBINDVERTEXARRAYPROC BindVertexArray; + PFNGLBLENDEQUATIONPROC BlendEquation; + PFNGLBLENDEQUATIONSEPARATEPROC BlendEquationSeparate; + PFNGLBLENDFUNCSEPARATEPROC BlendFuncSeparate; + PFNGLBUFFERDATAPROC BufferData; + PFNGLCLEARPROC Clear; + PFNGLCLEARCOLORPROC ClearColor; + PFNGLCOMPILESHADERPROC CompileShader; + PFNGLCREATEPROGRAMPROC CreateProgram; + PFNGLCREATESHADERPROC CreateShader; + PFNGLDELETEBUFFERSPROC DeleteBuffers; + PFNGLDELETEPROGRAMPROC DeleteProgram; + PFNGLDELETESHADERPROC DeleteShader; + PFNGLDELETETEXTURESPROC DeleteTextures; + PFNGLDELETEVERTEXARRAYSPROC DeleteVertexArrays; + PFNGLDETACHSHADERPROC DetachShader; + PFNGLDISABLEPROC Disable; + PFNGLDRAWELEMENTSPROC DrawElements; + PFNGLDRAWELEMENTSBASEVERTEXPROC DrawElementsBaseVertex; + PFNGLENABLEPROC Enable; + PFNGLENABLEVERTEXATTRIBARRAYPROC EnableVertexAttribArray; + PFNGLGENBUFFERSPROC GenBuffers; + PFNGLGENTEXTURESPROC GenTextures; + PFNGLGENVERTEXARRAYSPROC GenVertexArrays; + PFNGLGETATTRIBLOCATIONPROC GetAttribLocation; + PFNGLGETINTEGERVPROC GetIntegerv; + PFNGLGETPROGRAMINFOLOGPROC GetProgramInfoLog; + PFNGLGETPROGRAMIVPROC GetProgramiv; + PFNGLGETSHADERINFOLOGPROC GetShaderInfoLog; + PFNGLGETSHADERIVPROC GetShaderiv; + PFNGLGETSTRINGPROC GetString; + PFNGLGETSTRINGIPROC GetStringi; + PFNGLGETUNIFORMLOCATIONPROC GetUniformLocation; + PFNGLISENABLEDPROC IsEnabled; + PFNGLLINKPROGRAMPROC LinkProgram; + PFNGLPIXELSTOREIPROC PixelStorei; + PFNGLPOLYGONMODEPROC PolygonMode; + PFNGLREADPIXELSPROC ReadPixels; + PFNGLSCISSORPROC Scissor; + PFNGLSHADERSOURCEPROC ShaderSource; + PFNGLTEXIMAGE2DPROC TexImage2D; + PFNGLTEXPARAMETERIPROC TexParameteri; + PFNGLUNIFORM1IPROC Uniform1i; + PFNGLUNIFORMMATRIX4FVPROC UniformMatrix4fv; + PFNGLUSEPROGRAMPROC UseProgram; + PFNGLVERTEXATTRIBPOINTERPROC VertexAttribPointer; + PFNGLVIEWPORTPROC Viewport; + } gl; +}; + +GL3W_API extern union GL3WProcs gl3wProcs; + +/* OpenGL functions */ +#define glActiveTexture gl3wProcs.gl.ActiveTexture +#define glAttachShader gl3wProcs.gl.AttachShader +#define glBindBuffer gl3wProcs.gl.BindBuffer +#define glBindSampler gl3wProcs.gl.BindSampler +#define glBindTexture gl3wProcs.gl.BindTexture +#define glBindVertexArray gl3wProcs.gl.BindVertexArray +#define glBlendEquation gl3wProcs.gl.BlendEquation +#define glBlendEquationSeparate gl3wProcs.gl.BlendEquationSeparate +#define glBlendFuncSeparate gl3wProcs.gl.BlendFuncSeparate +#define glBufferData gl3wProcs.gl.BufferData +#define glClear gl3wProcs.gl.Clear +#define glClearColor gl3wProcs.gl.ClearColor +#define glCompileShader gl3wProcs.gl.CompileShader +#define glCreateProgram gl3wProcs.gl.CreateProgram +#define glCreateShader gl3wProcs.gl.CreateShader +#define glDeleteBuffers gl3wProcs.gl.DeleteBuffers +#define glDeleteProgram gl3wProcs.gl.DeleteProgram +#define glDeleteShader gl3wProcs.gl.DeleteShader +#define glDeleteTextures gl3wProcs.gl.DeleteTextures +#define glDeleteVertexArrays gl3wProcs.gl.DeleteVertexArrays +#define glDetachShader gl3wProcs.gl.DetachShader +#define glDisable gl3wProcs.gl.Disable +#define glDrawElements gl3wProcs.gl.DrawElements +#define glDrawElementsBaseVertex gl3wProcs.gl.DrawElementsBaseVertex +#define glEnable gl3wProcs.gl.Enable +#define glEnableVertexAttribArray gl3wProcs.gl.EnableVertexAttribArray +#define glGenBuffers gl3wProcs.gl.GenBuffers +#define glGenTextures gl3wProcs.gl.GenTextures +#define glGenVertexArrays gl3wProcs.gl.GenVertexArrays +#define glGetAttribLocation gl3wProcs.gl.GetAttribLocation +#define glGetIntegerv gl3wProcs.gl.GetIntegerv +#define glGetProgramInfoLog gl3wProcs.gl.GetProgramInfoLog +#define glGetProgramiv gl3wProcs.gl.GetProgramiv +#define glGetShaderInfoLog gl3wProcs.gl.GetShaderInfoLog +#define glGetShaderiv gl3wProcs.gl.GetShaderiv +#define glGetString gl3wProcs.gl.GetString +#define glGetStringi gl3wProcs.gl.GetStringi +#define glGetUniformLocation gl3wProcs.gl.GetUniformLocation +#define glIsEnabled gl3wProcs.gl.IsEnabled +#define glLinkProgram gl3wProcs.gl.LinkProgram +#define glPixelStorei gl3wProcs.gl.PixelStorei +#define glPolygonMode gl3wProcs.gl.PolygonMode +#define glReadPixels gl3wProcs.gl.ReadPixels +#define glScissor gl3wProcs.gl.Scissor +#define glShaderSource gl3wProcs.gl.ShaderSource +#define glTexImage2D gl3wProcs.gl.TexImage2D +#define glTexParameteri gl3wProcs.gl.TexParameteri +#define glUniform1i gl3wProcs.gl.Uniform1i +#define glUniformMatrix4fv gl3wProcs.gl.UniformMatrix4fv +#define glUseProgram gl3wProcs.gl.UseProgram +#define glVertexAttribPointer gl3wProcs.gl.VertexAttribPointer +#define glViewport gl3wProcs.gl.Viewport + +#ifdef __cplusplus +} +#endif + +#endif + +#ifdef IMGL3W_IMPL +#ifdef __cplusplus +extern "C" { +#endif + +#include + +#define ARRAY_SIZE(x) (sizeof(x) / sizeof((x)[0])) + +#if defined(_WIN32) +#ifndef WIN32_LEAN_AND_MEAN +#define WIN32_LEAN_AND_MEAN 1 +#endif +#include + +static HMODULE libgl; +typedef PROC(__stdcall* GL3WglGetProcAddr)(LPCSTR); +static GL3WglGetProcAddr wgl_get_proc_address; + +static int open_libgl(void) +{ + libgl = LoadLibraryA("opengl32.dll"); + if (!libgl) + return GL3W_ERROR_LIBRARY_OPEN; + wgl_get_proc_address = (GL3WglGetProcAddr)GetProcAddress(libgl, "wglGetProcAddress"); + return GL3W_OK; +} + +static void close_libgl(void) { FreeLibrary(libgl); } +static GL3WglProc get_proc(const char *proc) +{ + GL3WglProc res; + res = (GL3WglProc)wgl_get_proc_address(proc); + if (!res) + res = (GL3WglProc)GetProcAddress(libgl, proc); + return res; +} +#elif defined(__APPLE__) +#include + +static void *libgl; +static int open_libgl(void) +{ + libgl = dlopen("/System/Library/Frameworks/OpenGL.framework/OpenGL", RTLD_LAZY | RTLD_LOCAL); + if (!libgl) + return GL3W_ERROR_LIBRARY_OPEN; + return GL3W_OK; +} + +static void close_libgl(void) { dlclose(libgl); } + +static GL3WglProc get_proc(const char *proc) +{ + GL3WglProc res; + *(void **)(&res) = dlsym(libgl, proc); + return res; +} +#else +#include + +static void *libgl; +static GL3WglProc (*glx_get_proc_address)(const GLubyte *); + +static int open_libgl(void) +{ + libgl = dlopen("libGL.so.1", RTLD_LAZY | RTLD_LOCAL); + if (!libgl) + return GL3W_ERROR_LIBRARY_OPEN; + *(void **)(&glx_get_proc_address) = dlsym(libgl, "glXGetProcAddressARB"); + return GL3W_OK; +} + +static void close_libgl(void) { dlclose(libgl); } + +static GL3WglProc get_proc(const char *proc) +{ + GL3WglProc res; + res = glx_get_proc_address((const GLubyte *)proc); + if (!res) + *(void **)(&res) = dlsym(libgl, proc); + return res; +} +#endif + +static struct { int major, minor; } version; + +static int parse_version(void) +{ + if (!glGetIntegerv) + return GL3W_ERROR_INIT; + glGetIntegerv(GL_MAJOR_VERSION, &version.major); + glGetIntegerv(GL_MINOR_VERSION, &version.minor); + if (version.major < 3) + return GL3W_ERROR_OPENGL_VERSION; + return GL3W_OK; +} + +static void load_procs(GL3WGetProcAddressProc proc); + +int imgl3wInit(void) +{ + int res = open_libgl(); + if (res) + return res; + atexit(close_libgl); + return imgl3wInit2(get_proc); +} + +int imgl3wInit2(GL3WGetProcAddressProc proc) +{ + load_procs(proc); + return parse_version(); +} + +int imgl3wIsSupported(int major, int minor) +{ + if (major < 3) + return 0; + if (version.major == major) + return version.minor >= minor; + return version.major >= major; +} + +GL3WglProc imgl3wGetProcAddress(const char *proc) { return get_proc(proc); } + +static const char *proc_names[] = { + "glActiveTexture", + "glAttachShader", + "glBindBuffer", + "glBindSampler", + "glBindTexture", + "glBindVertexArray", + "glBlendEquation", + "glBlendEquationSeparate", + "glBlendFuncSeparate", + "glBufferData", + "glClear", + "glClearColor", + "glCompileShader", + "glCreateProgram", + "glCreateShader", + "glDeleteBuffers", + "glDeleteProgram", + "glDeleteShader", + "glDeleteTextures", + "glDeleteVertexArrays", + "glDetachShader", + "glDisable", + "glDrawElements", + "glDrawElementsBaseVertex", + "glEnable", + "glEnableVertexAttribArray", + "glGenBuffers", + "glGenTextures", + "glGenVertexArrays", + "glGetAttribLocation", + "glGetIntegerv", + "glGetProgramInfoLog", + "glGetProgramiv", + "glGetShaderInfoLog", + "glGetShaderiv", + "glGetString", + "glGetStringi", + "glGetUniformLocation", + "glIsEnabled", + "glLinkProgram", + "glPixelStorei", + "glPolygonMode", + "glReadPixels", + "glScissor", + "glShaderSource", + "glTexImage2D", + "glTexParameteri", + "glUniform1i", + "glUniformMatrix4fv", + "glUseProgram", + "glVertexAttribPointer", + "glViewport", +}; + +GL3W_API union GL3WProcs gl3wProcs; + +static void load_procs(GL3WGetProcAddressProc proc) +{ + size_t i; + for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE(proc_names); i++) + gl3wProcs.ptr[i] = proc(proc_names[i]); +} + +#ifdef __cplusplus +} +#endif +#endif diff --git a/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/imgui-1.84.2/imgui_impl_sdl.cpp b/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/imgui-1.84.2/imgui_impl_sdl.cpp new file mode 100644 index 0000000..f567764 --- /dev/null +++ b/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/imgui-1.84.2/imgui_impl_sdl.cpp @@ -0,0 +1,443 @@ +// dear imgui: Platform Backend for SDL2 +// This needs to be used along with a Renderer (e.g. DirectX11, OpenGL3, Vulkan..) +// (Info: SDL2 is a cross-platform general purpose library for handling windows, inputs, graphics context creation, etc.) +// (Prefer SDL 2.0.5+ for full feature support.) + +// Implemented features: +// [X] Platform: Mouse cursor shape and visibility. Disable with 'io.ConfigFlags |= ImGuiConfigFlags_NoMouseCursorChange'. +// [X] Platform: Clipboard support. +// [X] Platform: Keyboard arrays indexed using SDL_SCANCODE_* codes, e.g. ImGui::IsKeyPressed(SDL_SCANCODE_SPACE). +// [X] Platform: Gamepad support. Enabled with 'io.ConfigFlags |= ImGuiConfigFlags_NavEnableGamepad'. +// Missing features: +// [ ] Platform: SDL2 handling of IME under Windows appears to be broken and it explicitly disable the regular Windows IME. You can restore Windows IME by compiling SDL with SDL_DISABLE_WINDOWS_IME. + +// You can use unmodified imgui_impl_* files in your project. See examples/ folder for examples of using this. +// Prefer including the entire imgui/ repository into your project (either as a copy or as a submodule), and only build the backends you need. +// If you are new to Dear ImGui, read documentation from the docs/ folder + read the top of imgui.cpp. +// Read online: https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/tree/master/docs + +// CHANGELOG +// (minor and older changes stripped away, please see git history for details) +// 2021-08-17: Calling io.AddFocusEvent() on SDL_WINDOWEVENT_FOCUS_GAINED/SDL_WINDOWEVENT_FOCUS_LOST. +// 2021-07-29: Inputs: MousePos is correctly reported when the host platform window is hovered but not focused (using SDL_GetMouseFocus() + SDL_HINT_MOUSE_FOCUS_CLICKTHROUGH, requires SDL 2.0.5+) +// 2021-06-29: *BREAKING CHANGE* Removed 'SDL_Window* window' parameter to ImGui_ImplSDL2_NewFrame() which was unnecessary. +// 2021-06-29: Reorganized backend to pull data from a single structure to facilitate usage with multiple-contexts (all g_XXXX access changed to bd->XXXX). +// 2021-03-22: Rework global mouse pos availability check listing supported platforms explicitly, effectively fixing mouse access on Raspberry Pi. (#2837, #3950) +// 2020-05-25: Misc: Report a zero display-size when window is minimized, to be consistent with other backends. +// 2020-02-20: Inputs: Fixed mapping for ImGuiKey_KeyPadEnter (using SDL_SCANCODE_KP_ENTER instead of SDL_SCANCODE_RETURN2). +// 2019-12-17: Inputs: On Wayland, use SDL_GetMouseState (because there is no global mouse state). +// 2019-12-05: Inputs: Added support for ImGuiMouseCursor_NotAllowed mouse cursor. +// 2019-07-21: Inputs: Added mapping for ImGuiKey_KeyPadEnter. +// 2019-04-23: Inputs: Added support for SDL_GameController (if ImGuiConfigFlags_NavEnableGamepad is set by user application). +// 2019-03-12: Misc: Preserve DisplayFramebufferScale when main window is minimized. +// 2018-12-21: Inputs: Workaround for Android/iOS which don't seem to handle focus related calls. +// 2018-11-30: Misc: Setting up io.BackendPlatformName so it can be displayed in the About Window. +// 2018-11-14: Changed the signature of ImGui_ImplSDL2_ProcessEvent() to take a 'const SDL_Event*'. +// 2018-08-01: Inputs: Workaround for Emscripten which doesn't seem to handle focus related calls. +// 2018-06-29: Inputs: Added support for the ImGuiMouseCursor_Hand cursor. +// 2018-06-08: Misc: Extracted imgui_impl_sdl.cpp/.h away from the old combined SDL2+OpenGL/Vulkan examples. +// 2018-06-08: Misc: ImGui_ImplSDL2_InitForOpenGL() now takes a SDL_GLContext parameter. +// 2018-05-09: Misc: Fixed clipboard paste memory leak (we didn't call SDL_FreeMemory on the data returned by SDL_GetClipboardText). +// 2018-03-20: Misc: Setup io.BackendFlags ImGuiBackendFlags_HasMouseCursors flag + honor ImGuiConfigFlags_NoMouseCursorChange flag. +// 2018-02-16: Inputs: Added support for mouse cursors, honoring ImGui::GetMouseCursor() value. +// 2018-02-06: Misc: Removed call to ImGui::Shutdown() which is not available from 1.60 WIP, user needs to call CreateContext/DestroyContext themselves. +// 2018-02-06: Inputs: Added mapping for ImGuiKey_Space. +// 2018-02-05: Misc: Using SDL_GetPerformanceCounter() instead of SDL_GetTicks() to be able to handle very high framerate (1000+ FPS). +// 2018-02-05: Inputs: Keyboard mapping is using scancodes everywhere instead of a confusing mixture of keycodes and scancodes. +// 2018-01-20: Inputs: Added Horizontal Mouse Wheel support. +// 2018-01-19: Inputs: When available (SDL 2.0.4+) using SDL_CaptureMouse() to retrieve coordinates outside of client area when dragging. Otherwise (SDL 2.0.3 and before) testing for SDL_WINDOW_INPUT_FOCUS instead of SDL_WINDOW_MOUSE_FOCUS. +// 2018-01-18: Inputs: Added mapping for ImGuiKey_Insert. +// 2017-08-25: Inputs: MousePos set to -FLT_MAX,-FLT_MAX when mouse is unavailable/missing (instead of -1,-1). +// 2016-10-15: Misc: Added a void* user_data parameter to Clipboard function handlers. + +#include "imgui.h" +#include "imgui_impl_sdl.h" + +// SDL +#include +#include +#if defined(__APPLE__) +#include "TargetConditionals.h" +#endif + +#if SDL_VERSION_ATLEAST(2,0,4) && !defined(__EMSCRIPTEN__) && !defined(__ANDROID__) && !(defined(__APPLE__) && TARGET_OS_IOS) +#define SDL_HAS_CAPTURE_AND_GLOBAL_MOUSE 1 +#else +#define SDL_HAS_CAPTURE_AND_GLOBAL_MOUSE 0 +#endif +#define SDL_HAS_MOUSE_FOCUS_CLICKTHROUGH SDL_VERSION_ATLEAST(2,0,5) +#define SDL_HAS_VULKAN SDL_VERSION_ATLEAST(2,0,6) + +// SDL Data +struct ImGui_ImplSDL2_Data +{ + SDL_Window* Window; + Uint64 Time; + bool MousePressed[3]; + SDL_Cursor* MouseCursors[ImGuiMouseCursor_COUNT]; + char* ClipboardTextData; + bool MouseCanUseGlobalState; + + ImGui_ImplSDL2_Data() { memset(this, 0, sizeof(*this)); } +}; + +// Backend data stored in io.BackendPlatformUserData to allow support for multiple Dear ImGui contexts +// It is STRONGLY preferred that you use docking branch with multi-viewports (== single Dear ImGui context + multiple windows) instead of multiple Dear ImGui contexts. +// FIXME: multi-context support is not well tested and probably dysfunctional in this backend. +// FIXME: some shared resources (mouse cursor shape, gamepad) are mishandled when using multi-context. +static ImGui_ImplSDL2_Data* ImGui_ImplSDL2_GetBackendData() +{ + return ImGui::GetCurrentContext() ? (ImGui_ImplSDL2_Data*)ImGui::GetIO().BackendPlatformUserData : NULL; +} + +// Functions +static const char* ImGui_ImplSDL2_GetClipboardText(void*) +{ + ImGui_ImplSDL2_Data* bd = ImGui_ImplSDL2_GetBackendData(); + if (bd->ClipboardTextData) + SDL_free(bd->ClipboardTextData); + bd->ClipboardTextData = SDL_GetClipboardText(); + return bd->ClipboardTextData; +} + +static void ImGui_ImplSDL2_SetClipboardText(void*, const char* text) +{ + SDL_SetClipboardText(text); +} + +// You can read the io.WantCaptureMouse, io.WantCaptureKeyboard flags to tell if dear imgui wants to use your inputs. +// - When io.WantCaptureMouse is true, do not dispatch mouse input data to your main application. +// - When io.WantCaptureKeyboard is true, do not dispatch keyboard input data to your main application. +// Generally you may always pass all inputs to dear imgui, and hide them from your application based on those two flags. +// If you have multiple SDL events and some of them are not meant to be used by dear imgui, you may need to filter events based on their windowID field. +bool ImGui_ImplSDL2_ProcessEvent(const SDL_Event* event) +{ + ImGuiIO& io = ImGui::GetIO(); + ImGui_ImplSDL2_Data* bd = ImGui_ImplSDL2_GetBackendData(); + + switch (event->type) + { + case SDL_MOUSEWHEEL: + { + if (event->wheel.x > 0) io.MouseWheelH += 1; + if (event->wheel.x < 0) io.MouseWheelH -= 1; + if (event->wheel.y > 0) io.MouseWheel += 1; + if (event->wheel.y < 0) io.MouseWheel -= 1; + return true; + } + case SDL_MOUSEBUTTONDOWN: + { + if (event->button.button == SDL_BUTTON_LEFT) { bd->MousePressed[0] = true; } + if (event->button.button == SDL_BUTTON_RIGHT) { bd->MousePressed[1] = true; } + if (event->button.button == SDL_BUTTON_MIDDLE) { bd->MousePressed[2] = true; } + return true; + } + case SDL_TEXTINPUT: + { + io.AddInputCharactersUTF8(event->text.text); + return true; + } + case SDL_KEYDOWN: + case SDL_KEYUP: + { + int key = event->key.keysym.scancode; + IM_ASSERT(key >= 0 && key < IM_ARRAYSIZE(io.KeysDown)); + io.KeysDown[key] = (event->type == SDL_KEYDOWN); + io.KeyShift = ((SDL_GetModState() & KMOD_SHIFT) != 0); + io.KeyCtrl = ((SDL_GetModState() & KMOD_CTRL) != 0); + io.KeyAlt = ((SDL_GetModState() & KMOD_ALT) != 0); +#ifdef _WIN32 + io.KeySuper = false; +#else + io.KeySuper = ((SDL_GetModState() & KMOD_GUI) != 0); +#endif + return true; + } + case SDL_WINDOWEVENT: + { + if (event->window.event == SDL_WINDOWEVENT_FOCUS_GAINED) + io.AddFocusEvent(true); + else if (event->window.event == SDL_WINDOWEVENT_FOCUS_LOST) + io.AddFocusEvent(false); + return true; + } + } + return false; +} + +static bool ImGui_ImplSDL2_Init(SDL_Window* window) +{ + ImGuiIO& io = ImGui::GetIO(); + IM_ASSERT(io.BackendPlatformUserData == NULL && "Already initialized a platform backend!"); + + // Check and store if we are on a SDL backend that supports global mouse position + // ("wayland" and "rpi" don't support it, but we chose to use a white-list instead of a black-list) + bool mouse_can_use_global_state = false; +#if SDL_HAS_CAPTURE_AND_GLOBAL_MOUSE + const char* sdl_backend = SDL_GetCurrentVideoDriver(); + const char* global_mouse_whitelist[] = { "windows", "cocoa", "x11", "DIVE", "VMAN" }; + for (int n = 0; n < IM_ARRAYSIZE(global_mouse_whitelist); n++) + if (strncmp(sdl_backend, global_mouse_whitelist[n], strlen(global_mouse_whitelist[n])) == 0) + mouse_can_use_global_state = true; +#endif + + // Setup backend capabilities flags + ImGui_ImplSDL2_Data* bd = IM_NEW(ImGui_ImplSDL2_Data)(); + io.BackendPlatformUserData = (void*)bd; + io.BackendPlatformName = "imgui_impl_sdl"; + io.BackendFlags |= ImGuiBackendFlags_HasMouseCursors; // We can honor GetMouseCursor() values (optional) + io.BackendFlags |= ImGuiBackendFlags_HasSetMousePos; // We can honor io.WantSetMousePos requests (optional, rarely used) + + bd->Window = window; + bd->MouseCanUseGlobalState = mouse_can_use_global_state; + + // Keyboard mapping. Dear ImGui will use those indices to peek into the io.KeysDown[] array. + io.KeyMap[ImGuiKey_Tab] = SDL_SCANCODE_TAB; + io.KeyMap[ImGuiKey_LeftArrow] = SDL_SCANCODE_LEFT; + io.KeyMap[ImGuiKey_RightArrow] = SDL_SCANCODE_RIGHT; + io.KeyMap[ImGuiKey_UpArrow] = SDL_SCANCODE_UP; + io.KeyMap[ImGuiKey_DownArrow] = SDL_SCANCODE_DOWN; + io.KeyMap[ImGuiKey_PageUp] = SDL_SCANCODE_PAGEUP; + io.KeyMap[ImGuiKey_PageDown] = SDL_SCANCODE_PAGEDOWN; + io.KeyMap[ImGuiKey_Home] = SDL_SCANCODE_HOME; + io.KeyMap[ImGuiKey_End] = SDL_SCANCODE_END; + io.KeyMap[ImGuiKey_Insert] = SDL_SCANCODE_INSERT; + io.KeyMap[ImGuiKey_Delete] = SDL_SCANCODE_DELETE; + io.KeyMap[ImGuiKey_Backspace] = SDL_SCANCODE_BACKSPACE; + io.KeyMap[ImGuiKey_Space] = SDL_SCANCODE_SPACE; + io.KeyMap[ImGuiKey_Enter] = SDL_SCANCODE_RETURN; + io.KeyMap[ImGuiKey_Escape] = SDL_SCANCODE_ESCAPE; + io.KeyMap[ImGuiKey_KeyPadEnter] = SDL_SCANCODE_KP_ENTER; + io.KeyMap[ImGuiKey_A] = SDL_SCANCODE_A; + io.KeyMap[ImGuiKey_C] = SDL_SCANCODE_C; + io.KeyMap[ImGuiKey_V] = SDL_SCANCODE_V; + io.KeyMap[ImGuiKey_X] = SDL_SCANCODE_X; + io.KeyMap[ImGuiKey_Y] = SDL_SCANCODE_Y; + io.KeyMap[ImGuiKey_Z] = SDL_SCANCODE_Z; + + io.SetClipboardTextFn = ImGui_ImplSDL2_SetClipboardText; + io.GetClipboardTextFn = ImGui_ImplSDL2_GetClipboardText; + io.ClipboardUserData = NULL; + + // Load mouse cursors + bd->MouseCursors[ImGuiMouseCursor_Arrow] = SDL_CreateSystemCursor(SDL_SYSTEM_CURSOR_ARROW); + bd->MouseCursors[ImGuiMouseCursor_TextInput] = SDL_CreateSystemCursor(SDL_SYSTEM_CURSOR_IBEAM); + bd->MouseCursors[ImGuiMouseCursor_ResizeAll] = SDL_CreateSystemCursor(SDL_SYSTEM_CURSOR_SIZEALL); + bd->MouseCursors[ImGuiMouseCursor_ResizeNS] = SDL_CreateSystemCursor(SDL_SYSTEM_CURSOR_SIZENS); + bd->MouseCursors[ImGuiMouseCursor_ResizeEW] = SDL_CreateSystemCursor(SDL_SYSTEM_CURSOR_SIZEWE); + bd->MouseCursors[ImGuiMouseCursor_ResizeNESW] = SDL_CreateSystemCursor(SDL_SYSTEM_CURSOR_SIZENESW); + bd->MouseCursors[ImGuiMouseCursor_ResizeNWSE] = SDL_CreateSystemCursor(SDL_SYSTEM_CURSOR_SIZENWSE); + bd->MouseCursors[ImGuiMouseCursor_Hand] = SDL_CreateSystemCursor(SDL_SYSTEM_CURSOR_HAND); + bd->MouseCursors[ImGuiMouseCursor_NotAllowed] = SDL_CreateSystemCursor(SDL_SYSTEM_CURSOR_NO); + +#ifdef _WIN32 + SDL_SysWMinfo info; + SDL_VERSION(&info.version); + if (SDL_GetWindowWMInfo(window, &info)) + io.ImeWindowHandle = info.info.win.window; +#else + (void)window; +#endif + + // Set SDL hint to receive mouse click events on window focus, otherwise SDL doesn't emit the event. + // Without this, when clicking to gain focus, our widgets wouldn't activate even though they showed as hovered. + // (This is unfortunately a global SDL setting, so enabling it might have a side-effect on your application. + // It is unlikely to make a difference, but if your app absolutely needs to ignore the initial on-focus click: + // you can ignore SDL_MOUSEBUTTONDOWN events coming right after a SDL_WINDOWEVENT_FOCUS_GAINED) +#if SDL_HAS_MOUSE_FOCUS_CLICKTHROUGH + SDL_SetHint(SDL_HINT_MOUSE_FOCUS_CLICKTHROUGH, "1"); +#endif + + return true; +} + +bool ImGui_ImplSDL2_InitForOpenGL(SDL_Window* window, void* sdl_gl_context) +{ + IM_UNUSED(sdl_gl_context); // Viewport branch will need this. + return ImGui_ImplSDL2_Init(window); +} + +bool ImGui_ImplSDL2_InitForVulkan(SDL_Window* window) +{ +#if !SDL_HAS_VULKAN + IM_ASSERT(0 && "Unsupported"); +#endif + return ImGui_ImplSDL2_Init(window); +} + +bool ImGui_ImplSDL2_InitForD3D(SDL_Window* window) +{ +#if !defined(_WIN32) + IM_ASSERT(0 && "Unsupported"); +#endif + return ImGui_ImplSDL2_Init(window); +} + +bool ImGui_ImplSDL2_InitForMetal(SDL_Window* window) +{ + return ImGui_ImplSDL2_Init(window); +} + +void ImGui_ImplSDL2_Shutdown() +{ + ImGuiIO& io = ImGui::GetIO(); + ImGui_ImplSDL2_Data* bd = ImGui_ImplSDL2_GetBackendData(); + + if (bd->ClipboardTextData) + SDL_free(bd->ClipboardTextData); + for (ImGuiMouseCursor cursor_n = 0; cursor_n < ImGuiMouseCursor_COUNT; cursor_n++) + SDL_FreeCursor(bd->MouseCursors[cursor_n]); + + io.BackendPlatformName = NULL; + io.BackendPlatformUserData = NULL; + IM_DELETE(bd); +} + +static void ImGui_ImplSDL2_UpdateMousePosAndButtons() +{ + ImGui_ImplSDL2_Data* bd = ImGui_ImplSDL2_GetBackendData(); + ImGuiIO& io = ImGui::GetIO(); + + ImVec2 mouse_pos_prev = io.MousePos; + io.MousePos = ImVec2(-FLT_MAX, -FLT_MAX); + + // Update mouse buttons + int mouse_x_local, mouse_y_local; + Uint32 mouse_buttons = SDL_GetMouseState(&mouse_x_local, &mouse_y_local); + io.MouseDown[0] = bd->MousePressed[0] || (mouse_buttons & SDL_BUTTON(SDL_BUTTON_LEFT)) != 0; // If a mouse press event came, always pass it as "mouse held this frame", so we don't miss click-release events that are shorter than 1 frame. + io.MouseDown[1] = bd->MousePressed[1] || (mouse_buttons & SDL_BUTTON(SDL_BUTTON_RIGHT)) != 0; + io.MouseDown[2] = bd->MousePressed[2] || (mouse_buttons & SDL_BUTTON(SDL_BUTTON_MIDDLE)) != 0; + bd->MousePressed[0] = bd->MousePressed[1] = bd->MousePressed[2] = false; + + // Obtain focused and hovered window. We forward mouse input when focused or when hovered (and no other window is capturing) +#if SDL_HAS_CAPTURE_AND_GLOBAL_MOUSE + SDL_Window* focused_window = SDL_GetKeyboardFocus(); + SDL_Window* hovered_window = SDL_HAS_MOUSE_FOCUS_CLICKTHROUGH ? SDL_GetMouseFocus() : NULL; // This is better but is only reliably useful with SDL 2.0.5+ and SDL_HINT_MOUSE_FOCUS_CLICKTHROUGH. + SDL_Window* mouse_window = NULL; + if (hovered_window && bd->Window == hovered_window) + mouse_window = hovered_window; + else if (focused_window && bd->Window == focused_window) + mouse_window = focused_window; + + // SDL_CaptureMouse() let the OS know e.g. that our imgui drag outside the SDL window boundaries shouldn't e.g. trigger other operations outside + SDL_CaptureMouse(ImGui::IsAnyMouseDown() ? SDL_TRUE : SDL_FALSE); +#else + // SDL 2.0.3 and non-windowed systems: single-viewport only + SDL_Window* mouse_window = (SDL_GetWindowFlags(bd->Window) & SDL_WINDOW_INPUT_FOCUS) ? bd->Window : NULL; +#endif + + if (mouse_window == NULL) + return; + + // Set OS mouse position from Dear ImGui if requested (rarely used, only when ImGuiConfigFlags_NavEnableSetMousePos is enabled by user) + if (io.WantSetMousePos) + SDL_WarpMouseInWindow(bd->Window, (int)mouse_pos_prev.x, (int)mouse_pos_prev.y); + + // Set Dear ImGui mouse position from OS position + get buttons. (this is the common behavior) + if (bd->MouseCanUseGlobalState) + { + // Single-viewport mode: mouse position in client window coordinates (io.MousePos is (0,0) when the mouse is on the upper-left corner of the app window) + // Unlike local position obtained earlier this will be valid when straying out of bounds. + int mouse_x_global, mouse_y_global; + SDL_GetGlobalMouseState(&mouse_x_global, &mouse_y_global); + int window_x, window_y; + SDL_GetWindowPosition(mouse_window, &window_x, &window_y); + io.MousePos = ImVec2((float)(mouse_x_global - window_x), (float)(mouse_y_global - window_y)); + } + else + { + io.MousePos = ImVec2((float)mouse_x_local, (float)mouse_y_local); + } +} + +static void ImGui_ImplSDL2_UpdateMouseCursor() +{ + ImGuiIO& io = ImGui::GetIO(); + if (io.ConfigFlags & ImGuiConfigFlags_NoMouseCursorChange) + return; + ImGui_ImplSDL2_Data* bd = ImGui_ImplSDL2_GetBackendData(); + + ImGuiMouseCursor imgui_cursor = ImGui::GetMouseCursor(); + if (io.MouseDrawCursor || imgui_cursor == ImGuiMouseCursor_None) + { + // Hide OS mouse cursor if imgui is drawing it or if it wants no cursor + SDL_ShowCursor(SDL_FALSE); + } + else + { + // Show OS mouse cursor + SDL_SetCursor(bd->MouseCursors[imgui_cursor] ? bd->MouseCursors[imgui_cursor] : bd->MouseCursors[ImGuiMouseCursor_Arrow]); + SDL_ShowCursor(SDL_TRUE); + } +} + +static void ImGui_ImplSDL2_UpdateGamepads() +{ + ImGuiIO& io = ImGui::GetIO(); + memset(io.NavInputs, 0, sizeof(io.NavInputs)); + if ((io.ConfigFlags & ImGuiConfigFlags_NavEnableGamepad) == 0) + return; + + // Get gamepad + SDL_GameController* game_controller = SDL_GameControllerOpen(0); + if (!game_controller) + { + io.BackendFlags &= ~ImGuiBackendFlags_HasGamepad; + return; + } + + // Update gamepad inputs + #define MAP_BUTTON(NAV_NO, BUTTON_NO) { io.NavInputs[NAV_NO] = (SDL_GameControllerGetButton(game_controller, BUTTON_NO) != 0) ? 1.0f : 0.0f; } + #define MAP_ANALOG(NAV_NO, AXIS_NO, V0, V1) { float vn = (float)(SDL_GameControllerGetAxis(game_controller, AXIS_NO) - V0) / (float)(V1 - V0); if (vn > 1.0f) vn = 1.0f; if (vn > 0.0f && io.NavInputs[NAV_NO] < vn) io.NavInputs[NAV_NO] = vn; } + const int thumb_dead_zone = 8000; // SDL_gamecontroller.h suggests using this value. + MAP_BUTTON(ImGuiNavInput_Activate, SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_A); // Cross / A + MAP_BUTTON(ImGuiNavInput_Cancel, SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_B); // Circle / B + MAP_BUTTON(ImGuiNavInput_Menu, SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_X); // Square / X + MAP_BUTTON(ImGuiNavInput_Input, SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_Y); // Triangle / Y + MAP_BUTTON(ImGuiNavInput_DpadLeft, SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_DPAD_LEFT); // D-Pad Left + MAP_BUTTON(ImGuiNavInput_DpadRight, SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_DPAD_RIGHT); // D-Pad Right + MAP_BUTTON(ImGuiNavInput_DpadUp, SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_DPAD_UP); // D-Pad Up + MAP_BUTTON(ImGuiNavInput_DpadDown, SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_DPAD_DOWN); // D-Pad Down + MAP_BUTTON(ImGuiNavInput_FocusPrev, SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_LEFTSHOULDER); // L1 / LB + MAP_BUTTON(ImGuiNavInput_FocusNext, SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_RIGHTSHOULDER); // R1 / RB + MAP_BUTTON(ImGuiNavInput_TweakSlow, SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_LEFTSHOULDER); // L1 / LB + MAP_BUTTON(ImGuiNavInput_TweakFast, SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_RIGHTSHOULDER); // R1 / RB + MAP_ANALOG(ImGuiNavInput_LStickLeft, SDL_CONTROLLER_AXIS_LEFTX, -thumb_dead_zone, -32768); + MAP_ANALOG(ImGuiNavInput_LStickRight, SDL_CONTROLLER_AXIS_LEFTX, +thumb_dead_zone, +32767); + MAP_ANALOG(ImGuiNavInput_LStickUp, SDL_CONTROLLER_AXIS_LEFTY, -thumb_dead_zone, -32767); + MAP_ANALOG(ImGuiNavInput_LStickDown, SDL_CONTROLLER_AXIS_LEFTY, +thumb_dead_zone, +32767); + + io.BackendFlags |= ImGuiBackendFlags_HasGamepad; + #undef MAP_BUTTON + #undef MAP_ANALOG +} + +void ImGui_ImplSDL2_NewFrame() +{ + ImGui_ImplSDL2_Data* bd = ImGui_ImplSDL2_GetBackendData(); + IM_ASSERT(bd != NULL && "Did you call ImGui_ImplSDL2_Init()?"); + ImGuiIO& io = ImGui::GetIO(); + + // Setup display size (every frame to accommodate for window resizing) + int w, h; + int display_w, display_h; + SDL_GetWindowSize(bd->Window, &w, &h); + if (SDL_GetWindowFlags(bd->Window) & SDL_WINDOW_MINIMIZED) + w = h = 0; + SDL_GL_GetDrawableSize(bd->Window, &display_w, &display_h); + io.DisplaySize = ImVec2((float)w, (float)h); + if (w > 0 && h > 0) + io.DisplayFramebufferScale = ImVec2((float)display_w / w, (float)display_h / h); + + // Setup time step (we don't use SDL_GetTicks() because it is using millisecond resolution) + static Uint64 frequency = SDL_GetPerformanceFrequency(); + Uint64 current_time = SDL_GetPerformanceCounter(); + io.DeltaTime = bd->Time > 0 ? (float)((double)(current_time - bd->Time) / frequency) : (float)(1.0f / 60.0f); + bd->Time = current_time; + + ImGui_ImplSDL2_UpdateMousePosAndButtons(); + ImGui_ImplSDL2_UpdateMouseCursor(); + + // Update game controllers (if enabled and available) + ImGui_ImplSDL2_UpdateGamepads(); +} diff --git a/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/imgui-1.84.2/imgui_impl_sdl.h b/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/imgui-1.84.2/imgui_impl_sdl.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000..9b40a67 --- /dev/null +++ b/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/imgui-1.84.2/imgui_impl_sdl.h @@ -0,0 +1,34 @@ +// dear imgui: Platform Backend for SDL2 +// This needs to be used along with a Renderer (e.g. DirectX11, OpenGL3, Vulkan..) +// (Info: SDL2 is a cross-platform general purpose library for handling windows, inputs, graphics context creation, etc.) + +// Implemented features: +// [X] Platform: Mouse cursor shape and visibility. Disable with 'io.ConfigFlags |= ImGuiConfigFlags_NoMouseCursorChange'. +// [X] Platform: Clipboard support. +// [X] Platform: Keyboard arrays indexed using SDL_SCANCODE_* codes, e.g. ImGui::IsKeyPressed(SDL_SCANCODE_SPACE). +// [X] Platform: Gamepad support. Enabled with 'io.ConfigFlags |= ImGuiConfigFlags_NavEnableGamepad'. +// Missing features: +// [ ] Platform: SDL2 handling of IME under Windows appears to be broken and it explicitly disable the regular Windows IME. You can restore Windows IME by compiling SDL with SDL_DISABLE_WINDOWS_IME. + +// You can use unmodified imgui_impl_* files in your project. See examples/ folder for examples of using this. +// Prefer including the entire imgui/ repository into your project (either as a copy or as a submodule), and only build the backends you need. +// If you are new to Dear ImGui, read documentation from the docs/ folder + read the top of imgui.cpp. +// Read online: https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/tree/master/docs + +#pragma once +#include "imgui.h" // IMGUI_IMPL_API + +struct SDL_Window; +typedef union SDL_Event SDL_Event; + +IMGUI_IMPL_API bool ImGui_ImplSDL2_InitForOpenGL(SDL_Window* window, void* sdl_gl_context); +IMGUI_IMPL_API bool ImGui_ImplSDL2_InitForVulkan(SDL_Window* window); +IMGUI_IMPL_API bool ImGui_ImplSDL2_InitForD3D(SDL_Window* window); +IMGUI_IMPL_API bool ImGui_ImplSDL2_InitForMetal(SDL_Window* window); +IMGUI_IMPL_API void ImGui_ImplSDL2_Shutdown(); +IMGUI_IMPL_API void ImGui_ImplSDL2_NewFrame(); +IMGUI_IMPL_API bool ImGui_ImplSDL2_ProcessEvent(const SDL_Event* event); + +#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_OBSOLETE_FUNCTIONS +static inline void ImGui_ImplSDL2_NewFrame(SDL_Window*) { ImGui_ImplSDL2_NewFrame(); } // 1.84: removed unnecessary parameter +#endif diff --git a/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/imgui-1.84.2/imgui_internal.h b/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/imgui-1.84.2/imgui_internal.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000..1eb0cb7 --- /dev/null +++ b/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/imgui-1.84.2/imgui_internal.h @@ -0,0 +1,2749 @@ +// dear imgui, v1.84 +// (internal structures/api) + +// You may use this file to debug, understand or extend ImGui features but we don't provide any guarantee of forward compatibility! +// Set: +// #define IMGUI_DEFINE_MATH_OPERATORS +// To implement maths operators for ImVec2 (disabled by default to not collide with using IM_VEC2_CLASS_EXTRA along with your own math types+operators) + +/* + +Index of this file: + +// [SECTION] Header mess +// [SECTION] Forward declarations +// [SECTION] Context pointer +// [SECTION] STB libraries includes +// [SECTION] Macros +// [SECTION] Generic helpers +// [SECTION] ImDrawList support +// [SECTION] Widgets support: flags, enums, data structures +// [SECTION] Columns support +// [SECTION] Multi-select support +// [SECTION] Docking support +// [SECTION] Viewport support +// [SECTION] Settings support +// [SECTION] Metrics, Debug +// [SECTION] Generic context hooks +// [SECTION] ImGuiContext (main imgui context) +// [SECTION] ImGuiWindowTempData, ImGuiWindow +// [SECTION] Tab bar, Tab item support +// [SECTION] Table support +// [SECTION] ImGui internal API +// [SECTION] ImFontAtlas internal API +// [SECTION] Test Engine specific hooks (imgui_test_engine) + +*/ + +#pragma once +#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Header mess +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +#ifndef IMGUI_VERSION +#include "imgui.h" +#endif + +#include // FILE*, sscanf +#include // NULL, malloc, free, qsort, atoi, atof +#include // sqrtf, fabsf, fmodf, powf, floorf, ceilf, cosf, sinf +#include // INT_MIN, INT_MAX + +// Enable SSE intrinsics if available +#if (defined __SSE__ || defined __x86_64__ || defined _M_X64) && !defined(IMGUI_DISABLE_SSE) +#define IMGUI_ENABLE_SSE +#include +#endif + +// Visual Studio warnings +#ifdef _MSC_VER +#pragma warning (push) +#pragma warning (disable: 4251) // class 'xxx' needs to have dll-interface to be used by clients of struct 'xxx' // when IMGUI_API is set to__declspec(dllexport) +#pragma warning (disable: 26812) // The enum type 'xxx' is unscoped. Prefer 'enum class' over 'enum' (Enum.3). [MSVC Static Analyzer) +#pragma warning (disable: 26495) // [Static Analyzer] Variable 'XXX' is uninitialized. Always initialize a member variable (type.6). +#if defined(_MSC_VER) && _MSC_VER >= 1922 // MSVC 2019 16.2 or later +#pragma warning (disable: 5054) // operator '|': deprecated between enumerations of different types +#endif +#endif + +// Clang/GCC warnings with -Weverything +#if defined(__clang__) +#pragma clang diagnostic push +#if __has_warning("-Wunknown-warning-option") +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wunknown-warning-option" // warning: unknown warning group 'xxx' +#endif +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wunknown-pragmas" // warning: unknown warning group 'xxx' +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wfloat-equal" // warning: comparing floating point with == or != is unsafe // storing and comparing against same constants ok, for ImFloorSigned() +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wunused-function" // for stb_textedit.h +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wmissing-prototypes" // for stb_textedit.h +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wold-style-cast" +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wzero-as-null-pointer-constant" +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wdouble-promotion" +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wimplicit-int-float-conversion" // warning: implicit conversion from 'xxx' to 'float' may lose precision +#elif defined(__GNUC__) +#pragma GCC diagnostic push +#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wpragmas" // warning: unknown option after '#pragma GCC diagnostic' kind +#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wclass-memaccess" // [__GNUC__ >= 8] warning: 'memset/memcpy' clearing/writing an object of type 'xxxx' with no trivial copy-assignment; use assignment or value-initialization instead +#endif + +// Helper macros +#if defined(__clang__) +#define IM_NORETURN __attribute__((noreturn)) +#else +#define IM_NORETURN +#endif + +// Legacy defines +#ifdef IMGUI_DISABLE_FORMAT_STRING_FUNCTIONS // Renamed in 1.74 +#error Use IMGUI_DISABLE_DEFAULT_FORMAT_FUNCTIONS +#endif +#ifdef IMGUI_DISABLE_MATH_FUNCTIONS // Renamed in 1.74 +#error Use IMGUI_DISABLE_DEFAULT_MATH_FUNCTIONS +#endif + +// Enable stb_truetype by default unless FreeType is enabled. +// You can compile with both by defining both IMGUI_ENABLE_FREETYPE and IMGUI_ENABLE_STB_TRUETYPE together. +#ifndef IMGUI_ENABLE_FREETYPE +#define IMGUI_ENABLE_STB_TRUETYPE +#endif + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Forward declarations +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +struct ImBitVector; // Store 1-bit per value +struct ImRect; // An axis-aligned rectangle (2 points) +struct ImDrawDataBuilder; // Helper to build a ImDrawData instance +struct ImDrawListSharedData; // Data shared between all ImDrawList instances +struct ImGuiColorMod; // Stacked color modifier, backup of modified data so we can restore it +struct ImGuiContext; // Main Dear ImGui context +struct ImGuiContextHook; // Hook for extensions like ImGuiTestEngine +struct ImGuiDataTypeInfo; // Type information associated to a ImGuiDataType enum +struct ImGuiGroupData; // Stacked storage data for BeginGroup()/EndGroup() +struct ImGuiInputTextState; // Internal state of the currently focused/edited text input box +struct ImGuiLastItemData; // Status storage for last submitted items +struct ImGuiMenuColumns; // Simple column measurement, currently used for MenuItem() only +struct ImGuiNavItemData; // Result of a gamepad/keyboard directional navigation move query result +struct ImGuiMetricsConfig; // Storage for ShowMetricsWindow() and DebugNodeXXX() functions +struct ImGuiNextWindowData; // Storage for SetNextWindow** functions +struct ImGuiNextItemData; // Storage for SetNextItem** functions +struct ImGuiOldColumnData; // Storage data for a single column for legacy Columns() api +struct ImGuiOldColumns; // Storage data for a columns set for legacy Columns() api +struct ImGuiPopupData; // Storage for current popup stack +struct ImGuiSettingsHandler; // Storage for one type registered in the .ini file +struct ImGuiStackSizes; // Storage of stack sizes for debugging/asserting +struct ImGuiStyleMod; // Stacked style modifier, backup of modified data so we can restore it +struct ImGuiTabBar; // Storage for a tab bar +struct ImGuiTabItem; // Storage for a tab item (within a tab bar) +struct ImGuiTable; // Storage for a table +struct ImGuiTableColumn; // Storage for one column of a table +struct ImGuiTableTempData; // Temporary storage for one table (one per table in the stack), shared between tables. +struct ImGuiTableSettings; // Storage for a table .ini settings +struct ImGuiTableColumnsSettings; // Storage for a column .ini settings +struct ImGuiWindow; // Storage for one window +struct ImGuiWindowTempData; // Temporary storage for one window (that's the data which in theory we could ditch at the end of the frame, in practice we currently keep it for each window) +struct ImGuiWindowSettings; // Storage for a window .ini settings (we keep one of those even if the actual window wasn't instanced during this session) + +// Use your programming IDE "Go to definition" facility on the names of the center columns to find the actual flags/enum lists. +typedef int ImGuiLayoutType; // -> enum ImGuiLayoutType_ // Enum: Horizontal or vertical +typedef int ImGuiItemFlags; // -> enum ImGuiItemFlags_ // Flags: for PushItemFlag() +typedef int ImGuiItemAddFlags; // -> enum ImGuiItemAddFlags_ // Flags: for ItemAdd() +typedef int ImGuiItemStatusFlags; // -> enum ImGuiItemStatusFlags_ // Flags: for DC.LastItemStatusFlags +typedef int ImGuiOldColumnFlags; // -> enum ImGuiOldColumnFlags_ // Flags: for BeginColumns() +typedef int ImGuiNavHighlightFlags; // -> enum ImGuiNavHighlightFlags_ // Flags: for RenderNavHighlight() +typedef int ImGuiNavDirSourceFlags; // -> enum ImGuiNavDirSourceFlags_ // Flags: for GetNavInputAmount2d() +typedef int ImGuiNavMoveFlags; // -> enum ImGuiNavMoveFlags_ // Flags: for navigation requests +typedef int ImGuiNextItemDataFlags; // -> enum ImGuiNextItemDataFlags_ // Flags: for SetNextItemXXX() functions +typedef int ImGuiNextWindowDataFlags; // -> enum ImGuiNextWindowDataFlags_// Flags: for SetNextWindowXXX() functions +typedef int ImGuiSeparatorFlags; // -> enum ImGuiSeparatorFlags_ // Flags: for SeparatorEx() +typedef int ImGuiTextFlags; // -> enum ImGuiTextFlags_ // Flags: for TextEx() +typedef int ImGuiTooltipFlags; // -> enum ImGuiTooltipFlags_ // Flags: for BeginTooltipEx() + +typedef void (*ImGuiErrorLogCallback)(void* user_data, const char* fmt, ...); + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Context pointer +// See implementation of this variable in imgui.cpp for comments and details. +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +#ifndef GImGui +extern IMGUI_API ImGuiContext* GImGui; // Current implicit context pointer +#endif + +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] STB libraries includes +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +namespace ImStb +{ + +#undef STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING +#undef STB_TEXTEDIT_CHARTYPE +#define STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING ImGuiInputTextState +#define STB_TEXTEDIT_CHARTYPE ImWchar +#define STB_TEXTEDIT_GETWIDTH_NEWLINE (-1.0f) +#define STB_TEXTEDIT_UNDOSTATECOUNT 99 +#define STB_TEXTEDIT_UNDOCHARCOUNT 999 +#include "imstb_textedit.h" + +} // namespace ImStb + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Macros +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// Debug Logging +#ifndef IMGUI_DEBUG_LOG +#define IMGUI_DEBUG_LOG(_FMT,...) printf("[%05d] " _FMT, GImGui->FrameCount, __VA_ARGS__) +#endif + +// Debug Logging for selected systems. Remove the '((void)0) //' to enable. +//#define IMGUI_DEBUG_LOG_POPUP IMGUI_DEBUG_LOG // Enable log +//#define IMGUI_DEBUG_LOG_NAV IMGUI_DEBUG_LOG // Enable log +#define IMGUI_DEBUG_LOG_POPUP(...) ((void)0) // Disable log +#define IMGUI_DEBUG_LOG_NAV(...) ((void)0) // Disable log + +// Static Asserts +#if (__cplusplus >= 201100) || (defined(_MSVC_LANG) && _MSVC_LANG >= 201100) +#define IM_STATIC_ASSERT(_COND) static_assert(_COND, "") +#else +#define IM_STATIC_ASSERT(_COND) typedef char static_assertion_##__line__[(_COND)?1:-1] +#endif + +// "Paranoid" Debug Asserts are meant to only be enabled during specific debugging/work, otherwise would slow down the code too much. +// We currently don't have many of those so the effect is currently negligible, but onward intent to add more aggressive ones in the code. +//#define IMGUI_DEBUG_PARANOID +#ifdef IMGUI_DEBUG_PARANOID +#define IM_ASSERT_PARANOID(_EXPR) IM_ASSERT(_EXPR) +#else +#define IM_ASSERT_PARANOID(_EXPR) +#endif + +// Error handling +// Down the line in some frameworks/languages we would like to have a way to redirect those to the programmer and recover from more faults. +#ifndef IM_ASSERT_USER_ERROR +#define IM_ASSERT_USER_ERROR(_EXP,_MSG) IM_ASSERT((_EXP) && _MSG) // Recoverable User Error +#endif + +// Misc Macros +#define IM_PI 3.14159265358979323846f +#ifdef _WIN32 +#define IM_NEWLINE "\r\n" // Play it nice with Windows users (Update: since 2018-05, Notepad finally appears to support Unix-style carriage returns!) +#else +#define IM_NEWLINE "\n" +#endif +#define IM_TABSIZE (4) +#define IM_MEMALIGN(_OFF,_ALIGN) (((_OFF) + (_ALIGN - 1)) & ~(_ALIGN - 1)) // Memory align e.g. IM_ALIGN(0,4)=0, IM_ALIGN(1,4)=4, IM_ALIGN(4,4)=4, IM_ALIGN(5,4)=8 +#define IM_F32_TO_INT8_UNBOUND(_VAL) ((int)((_VAL) * 255.0f + ((_VAL)>=0 ? 0.5f : -0.5f))) // Unsaturated, for display purpose +#define IM_F32_TO_INT8_SAT(_VAL) ((int)(ImSaturate(_VAL) * 255.0f + 0.5f)) // Saturated, always output 0..255 +#define IM_FLOOR(_VAL) ((float)(int)(_VAL)) // ImFloor() is not inlined in MSVC debug builds +#define IM_ROUND(_VAL) ((float)(int)((_VAL) + 0.5f)) // + +// Enforce cdecl calling convention for functions called by the standard library, in case compilation settings changed the default to e.g. __vectorcall +#ifdef _MSC_VER +#define IMGUI_CDECL __cdecl +#else +#define IMGUI_CDECL +#endif + +// Warnings +#if defined(_MSC_VER) && !defined(__clang__) +#define IM_MSVC_WARNING_SUPPRESS(XXXX) __pragma(warning(suppress: XXXX)) +#else +#define IM_MSVC_WARNING_SUPPRESS(XXXX) +#endif + +// Debug Tools +// Use 'Metrics->Tools->Item Picker' to break into the call-stack of a specific item. +#ifndef IM_DEBUG_BREAK +#if defined(__clang__) +#define IM_DEBUG_BREAK() __builtin_debugtrap() +#elif defined (_MSC_VER) +#define IM_DEBUG_BREAK() __debugbreak() +#else +#define IM_DEBUG_BREAK() IM_ASSERT(0) // It is expected that you define IM_DEBUG_BREAK() into something that will break nicely in a debugger! +#endif +#endif // #ifndef IM_DEBUG_BREAK + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Generic helpers +// Note that the ImXXX helpers functions are lower-level than ImGui functions. +// ImGui functions or the ImGui context are never called/used from other ImXXX functions. +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// - Helpers: Hashing +// - Helpers: Sorting +// - Helpers: Bit manipulation +// - Helpers: String, Formatting +// - Helpers: UTF-8 <> wchar conversions +// - Helpers: ImVec2/ImVec4 operators +// - Helpers: Maths +// - Helpers: Geometry +// - Helper: ImVec1 +// - Helper: ImVec2ih +// - Helper: ImRect +// - Helper: ImBitArray +// - Helper: ImBitVector +// - Helper: ImSpan<>, ImSpanAllocator<> +// - Helper: ImPool<> +// - Helper: ImChunkStream<> +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// Helpers: Hashing +IMGUI_API ImGuiID ImHashData(const void* data, size_t data_size, ImU32 seed = 0); +IMGUI_API ImGuiID ImHashStr(const char* data, size_t data_size = 0, ImU32 seed = 0); +#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_OBSOLETE_FUNCTIONS +static inline ImGuiID ImHash(const void* data, int size, ImU32 seed = 0) { return size ? ImHashData(data, (size_t)size, seed) : ImHashStr((const char*)data, 0, seed); } // [moved to ImHashStr/ImHashData in 1.68] +#endif + +// Helpers: Sorting +#define ImQsort qsort + +// Helpers: Color Blending +IMGUI_API ImU32 ImAlphaBlendColors(ImU32 col_a, ImU32 col_b); + +// Helpers: Bit manipulation +static inline bool ImIsPowerOfTwo(int v) { return v != 0 && (v & (v - 1)) == 0; } +static inline bool ImIsPowerOfTwo(ImU64 v) { return v != 0 && (v & (v - 1)) == 0; } +static inline int ImUpperPowerOfTwo(int v) { v--; v |= v >> 1; v |= v >> 2; v |= v >> 4; v |= v >> 8; v |= v >> 16; v++; return v; } + +// Helpers: String, Formatting +IMGUI_API int ImStricmp(const char* str1, const char* str2); +IMGUI_API int ImStrnicmp(const char* str1, const char* str2, size_t count); +IMGUI_API void ImStrncpy(char* dst, const char* src, size_t count); +IMGUI_API char* ImStrdup(const char* str); +IMGUI_API char* ImStrdupcpy(char* dst, size_t* p_dst_size, const char* str); +IMGUI_API const char* ImStrchrRange(const char* str_begin, const char* str_end, char c); +IMGUI_API int ImStrlenW(const ImWchar* str); +IMGUI_API const char* ImStreolRange(const char* str, const char* str_end); // End end-of-line +IMGUI_API const ImWchar*ImStrbolW(const ImWchar* buf_mid_line, const ImWchar* buf_begin); // Find beginning-of-line +IMGUI_API const char* ImStristr(const char* haystack, const char* haystack_end, const char* needle, const char* needle_end); +IMGUI_API void ImStrTrimBlanks(char* str); +IMGUI_API const char* ImStrSkipBlank(const char* str); +IMGUI_API int ImFormatString(char* buf, size_t buf_size, const char* fmt, ...) IM_FMTARGS(3); +IMGUI_API int ImFormatStringV(char* buf, size_t buf_size, const char* fmt, va_list args) IM_FMTLIST(3); +IMGUI_API const char* ImParseFormatFindStart(const char* format); +IMGUI_API const char* ImParseFormatFindEnd(const char* format); +IMGUI_API const char* ImParseFormatTrimDecorations(const char* format, char* buf, size_t buf_size); +IMGUI_API int ImParseFormatPrecision(const char* format, int default_value); +static inline bool ImCharIsBlankA(char c) { return c == ' ' || c == '\t'; } +static inline bool ImCharIsBlankW(unsigned int c) { return c == ' ' || c == '\t' || c == 0x3000; } + +// Helpers: UTF-8 <> wchar conversions +IMGUI_API const char* ImTextCharToUtf8(char out_buf[5], unsigned int c); // return out_buf +IMGUI_API int ImTextStrToUtf8(char* out_buf, int out_buf_size, const ImWchar* in_text, const ImWchar* in_text_end); // return output UTF-8 bytes count +IMGUI_API int ImTextCharFromUtf8(unsigned int* out_char, const char* in_text, const char* in_text_end); // read one character. return input UTF-8 bytes count +IMGUI_API int ImTextStrFromUtf8(ImWchar* out_buf, int out_buf_size, const char* in_text, const char* in_text_end, const char** in_remaining = NULL); // return input UTF-8 bytes count +IMGUI_API int ImTextCountCharsFromUtf8(const char* in_text, const char* in_text_end); // return number of UTF-8 code-points (NOT bytes count) +IMGUI_API int ImTextCountUtf8BytesFromChar(const char* in_text, const char* in_text_end); // return number of bytes to express one char in UTF-8 +IMGUI_API int ImTextCountUtf8BytesFromStr(const ImWchar* in_text, const ImWchar* in_text_end); // return number of bytes to express string in UTF-8 + +// Helpers: ImVec2/ImVec4 operators +// We are keeping those disabled by default so they don't leak in user space, to allow user enabling implicit cast operators between ImVec2 and their own types (using IM_VEC2_CLASS_EXTRA etc.) +// We unfortunately don't have a unary- operator for ImVec2 because this would needs to be defined inside the class itself. +#ifdef IMGUI_DEFINE_MATH_OPERATORS +IM_MSVC_RUNTIME_CHECKS_OFF +static inline ImVec2 operator*(const ImVec2& lhs, const float rhs) { return ImVec2(lhs.x * rhs, lhs.y * rhs); } +static inline ImVec2 operator/(const ImVec2& lhs, const float rhs) { return ImVec2(lhs.x / rhs, lhs.y / rhs); } +static inline ImVec2 operator+(const ImVec2& lhs, const ImVec2& rhs) { return ImVec2(lhs.x + rhs.x, lhs.y + rhs.y); } +static inline ImVec2 operator-(const ImVec2& lhs, const ImVec2& rhs) { return ImVec2(lhs.x - rhs.x, lhs.y - rhs.y); } +static inline ImVec2 operator*(const ImVec2& lhs, const ImVec2& rhs) { return ImVec2(lhs.x * rhs.x, lhs.y * rhs.y); } +static inline ImVec2 operator/(const ImVec2& lhs, const ImVec2& rhs) { return ImVec2(lhs.x / rhs.x, lhs.y / rhs.y); } +static inline ImVec2& operator*=(ImVec2& lhs, const float rhs) { lhs.x *= rhs; lhs.y *= rhs; return lhs; } +static inline ImVec2& operator/=(ImVec2& lhs, const float rhs) { lhs.x /= rhs; lhs.y /= rhs; return lhs; } +static inline ImVec2& operator+=(ImVec2& lhs, const ImVec2& rhs) { lhs.x += rhs.x; lhs.y += rhs.y; return lhs; } +static inline ImVec2& operator-=(ImVec2& lhs, const ImVec2& rhs) { lhs.x -= rhs.x; lhs.y -= rhs.y; return lhs; } +static inline ImVec2& operator*=(ImVec2& lhs, const ImVec2& rhs) { lhs.x *= rhs.x; lhs.y *= rhs.y; return lhs; } +static inline ImVec2& operator/=(ImVec2& lhs, const ImVec2& rhs) { lhs.x /= rhs.x; lhs.y /= rhs.y; return lhs; } +static inline ImVec4 operator+(const ImVec4& lhs, const ImVec4& rhs) { return ImVec4(lhs.x + rhs.x, lhs.y + rhs.y, lhs.z + rhs.z, lhs.w + rhs.w); } +static inline ImVec4 operator-(const ImVec4& lhs, const ImVec4& rhs) { return ImVec4(lhs.x - rhs.x, lhs.y - rhs.y, lhs.z - rhs.z, lhs.w - rhs.w); } +static inline ImVec4 operator*(const ImVec4& lhs, const ImVec4& rhs) { return ImVec4(lhs.x * rhs.x, lhs.y * rhs.y, lhs.z * rhs.z, lhs.w * rhs.w); } +IM_MSVC_RUNTIME_CHECKS_RESTORE +#endif + +// Helpers: File System +#ifdef IMGUI_DISABLE_FILE_FUNCTIONS +#define IMGUI_DISABLE_DEFAULT_FILE_FUNCTIONS +typedef void* ImFileHandle; +static inline ImFileHandle ImFileOpen(const char*, const char*) { return NULL; } +static inline bool ImFileClose(ImFileHandle) { return false; } +static inline ImU64 ImFileGetSize(ImFileHandle) { return (ImU64)-1; } +static inline ImU64 ImFileRead(void*, ImU64, ImU64, ImFileHandle) { return 0; } +static inline ImU64 ImFileWrite(const void*, ImU64, ImU64, ImFileHandle) { return 0; } +#endif +#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_DEFAULT_FILE_FUNCTIONS +typedef FILE* ImFileHandle; +IMGUI_API ImFileHandle ImFileOpen(const char* filename, const char* mode); +IMGUI_API bool ImFileClose(ImFileHandle file); +IMGUI_API ImU64 ImFileGetSize(ImFileHandle file); +IMGUI_API ImU64 ImFileRead(void* data, ImU64 size, ImU64 count, ImFileHandle file); +IMGUI_API ImU64 ImFileWrite(const void* data, ImU64 size, ImU64 count, ImFileHandle file); +#else +#define IMGUI_DISABLE_TTY_FUNCTIONS // Can't use stdout, fflush if we are not using default file functions +#endif +IMGUI_API void* ImFileLoadToMemory(const char* filename, const char* mode, size_t* out_file_size = NULL, int padding_bytes = 0); + +// Helpers: Maths +IM_MSVC_RUNTIME_CHECKS_OFF +// - Wrapper for standard libs functions. (Note that imgui_demo.cpp does _not_ use them to keep the code easy to copy) +#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_DEFAULT_MATH_FUNCTIONS +#define ImFabs(X) fabsf(X) +#define ImSqrt(X) sqrtf(X) +#define ImFmod(X, Y) fmodf((X), (Y)) +#define ImCos(X) cosf(X) +#define ImSin(X) sinf(X) +#define ImAcos(X) acosf(X) +#define ImAtan2(Y, X) atan2f((Y), (X)) +#define ImAtof(STR) atof(STR) +//#define ImFloorStd(X) floorf(X) // We use our own, see ImFloor() and ImFloorSigned() +#define ImCeil(X) ceilf(X) +static inline float ImPow(float x, float y) { return powf(x, y); } // DragBehaviorT/SliderBehaviorT uses ImPow with either float/double and need the precision +static inline double ImPow(double x, double y) { return pow(x, y); } +static inline float ImLog(float x) { return logf(x); } // DragBehaviorT/SliderBehaviorT uses ImLog with either float/double and need the precision +static inline double ImLog(double x) { return log(x); } +static inline int ImAbs(int x) { return x < 0 ? -x : x; } +static inline float ImAbs(float x) { return fabsf(x); } +static inline double ImAbs(double x) { return fabs(x); } +static inline float ImSign(float x) { return (x < 0.0f) ? -1.0f : ((x > 0.0f) ? 1.0f : 0.0f); } // Sign operator - returns -1, 0 or 1 based on sign of argument +static inline double ImSign(double x) { return (x < 0.0) ? -1.0 : ((x > 0.0) ? 1.0 : 0.0); } +#ifdef IMGUI_ENABLE_SSE +static inline float ImRsqrt(float x) { return _mm_cvtss_f32(_mm_rsqrt_ss(_mm_set_ss(x))); } +#else +static inline float ImRsqrt(float x) { return 1.0f / sqrtf(x); } +#endif +static inline double ImRsqrt(double x) { return 1.0 / sqrt(x); } +#endif +// - ImMin/ImMax/ImClamp/ImLerp/ImSwap are used by widgets which support variety of types: signed/unsigned int/long long float/double +// (Exceptionally using templates here but we could also redefine them for those types) +template static inline T ImMin(T lhs, T rhs) { return lhs < rhs ? lhs : rhs; } +template static inline T ImMax(T lhs, T rhs) { return lhs >= rhs ? lhs : rhs; } +template static inline T ImClamp(T v, T mn, T mx) { return (v < mn) ? mn : (v > mx) ? mx : v; } +template static inline T ImLerp(T a, T b, float t) { return (T)(a + (b - a) * t); } +template static inline void ImSwap(T& a, T& b) { T tmp = a; a = b; b = tmp; } +template static inline T ImAddClampOverflow(T a, T b, T mn, T mx) { if (b < 0 && (a < mn - b)) return mn; if (b > 0 && (a > mx - b)) return mx; return a + b; } +template static inline T ImSubClampOverflow(T a, T b, T mn, T mx) { if (b > 0 && (a < mn + b)) return mn; if (b < 0 && (a > mx + b)) return mx; return a - b; } +// - Misc maths helpers +static inline ImVec2 ImMin(const ImVec2& lhs, const ImVec2& rhs) { return ImVec2(lhs.x < rhs.x ? lhs.x : rhs.x, lhs.y < rhs.y ? lhs.y : rhs.y); } +static inline ImVec2 ImMax(const ImVec2& lhs, const ImVec2& rhs) { return ImVec2(lhs.x >= rhs.x ? lhs.x : rhs.x, lhs.y >= rhs.y ? lhs.y : rhs.y); } +static inline ImVec2 ImClamp(const ImVec2& v, const ImVec2& mn, ImVec2 mx) { return ImVec2((v.x < mn.x) ? mn.x : (v.x > mx.x) ? mx.x : v.x, (v.y < mn.y) ? mn.y : (v.y > mx.y) ? mx.y : v.y); } +static inline ImVec2 ImLerp(const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& b, float t) { return ImVec2(a.x + (b.x - a.x) * t, a.y + (b.y - a.y) * t); } +static inline ImVec2 ImLerp(const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& b, const ImVec2& t) { return ImVec2(a.x + (b.x - a.x) * t.x, a.y + (b.y - a.y) * t.y); } +static inline ImVec4 ImLerp(const ImVec4& a, const ImVec4& b, float t) { return ImVec4(a.x + (b.x - a.x) * t, a.y + (b.y - a.y) * t, a.z + (b.z - a.z) * t, a.w + (b.w - a.w) * t); } +static inline float ImSaturate(float f) { return (f < 0.0f) ? 0.0f : (f > 1.0f) ? 1.0f : f; } +static inline float ImLengthSqr(const ImVec2& lhs) { return (lhs.x * lhs.x) + (lhs.y * lhs.y); } +static inline float ImLengthSqr(const ImVec4& lhs) { return (lhs.x * lhs.x) + (lhs.y * lhs.y) + (lhs.z * lhs.z) + (lhs.w * lhs.w); } +static inline float ImInvLength(const ImVec2& lhs, float fail_value) { float d = (lhs.x * lhs.x) + (lhs.y * lhs.y); if (d > 0.0f) return ImRsqrt(d); return fail_value; } +static inline float ImFloor(float f) { return (float)(int)(f); } +static inline float ImFloorSigned(float f) { return (float)((f >= 0 || (int)f == f) ? (int)f : (int)f - 1); } // Decent replacement for floorf() +static inline ImVec2 ImFloor(const ImVec2& v) { return ImVec2((float)(int)(v.x), (float)(int)(v.y)); } +static inline int ImModPositive(int a, int b) { return (a + b) % b; } +static inline float ImDot(const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& b) { return a.x * b.x + a.y * b.y; } +static inline ImVec2 ImRotate(const ImVec2& v, float cos_a, float sin_a) { return ImVec2(v.x * cos_a - v.y * sin_a, v.x * sin_a + v.y * cos_a); } +static inline float ImLinearSweep(float current, float target, float speed) { if (current < target) return ImMin(current + speed, target); if (current > target) return ImMax(current - speed, target); return current; } +static inline ImVec2 ImMul(const ImVec2& lhs, const ImVec2& rhs) { return ImVec2(lhs.x * rhs.x, lhs.y * rhs.y); } +IM_MSVC_RUNTIME_CHECKS_RESTORE + +// Helpers: Geometry +IMGUI_API ImVec2 ImBezierCubicCalc(const ImVec2& p1, const ImVec2& p2, const ImVec2& p3, const ImVec2& p4, float t); +IMGUI_API ImVec2 ImBezierCubicClosestPoint(const ImVec2& p1, const ImVec2& p2, const ImVec2& p3, const ImVec2& p4, const ImVec2& p, int num_segments); // For curves with explicit number of segments +IMGUI_API ImVec2 ImBezierCubicClosestPointCasteljau(const ImVec2& p1, const ImVec2& p2, const ImVec2& p3, const ImVec2& p4, const ImVec2& p, float tess_tol);// For auto-tessellated curves you can use tess_tol = style.CurveTessellationTol +IMGUI_API ImVec2 ImBezierQuadraticCalc(const ImVec2& p1, const ImVec2& p2, const ImVec2& p3, float t); +IMGUI_API ImVec2 ImLineClosestPoint(const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& b, const ImVec2& p); +IMGUI_API bool ImTriangleContainsPoint(const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& b, const ImVec2& c, const ImVec2& p); +IMGUI_API ImVec2 ImTriangleClosestPoint(const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& b, const ImVec2& c, const ImVec2& p); +IMGUI_API void ImTriangleBarycentricCoords(const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& b, const ImVec2& c, const ImVec2& p, float& out_u, float& out_v, float& out_w); +inline float ImTriangleArea(const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& b, const ImVec2& c) { return ImFabs((a.x * (b.y - c.y)) + (b.x * (c.y - a.y)) + (c.x * (a.y - b.y))) * 0.5f; } +IMGUI_API ImGuiDir ImGetDirQuadrantFromDelta(float dx, float dy); + +// Helper: ImVec1 (1D vector) +// (this odd construct is used to facilitate the transition between 1D and 2D, and the maintenance of some branches/patches) +IM_MSVC_RUNTIME_CHECKS_OFF +struct ImVec1 +{ + float x; + ImVec1() { x = 0.0f; } + ImVec1(float _x) { x = _x; } +}; + +// Helper: ImVec2ih (2D vector, half-size integer, for long-term packed storage) +struct ImVec2ih +{ + short x, y; + ImVec2ih() { x = y = 0; } + ImVec2ih(short _x, short _y) { x = _x; y = _y; } + explicit ImVec2ih(const ImVec2& rhs) { x = (short)rhs.x; y = (short)rhs.y; } +}; + +// Helper: ImRect (2D axis aligned bounding-box) +// NB: we can't rely on ImVec2 math operators being available here! +struct IMGUI_API ImRect +{ + ImVec2 Min; // Upper-left + ImVec2 Max; // Lower-right + + ImRect() : Min(0.0f, 0.0f), Max(0.0f, 0.0f) {} + ImRect(const ImVec2& min, const ImVec2& max) : Min(min), Max(max) {} + ImRect(const ImVec4& v) : Min(v.x, v.y), Max(v.z, v.w) {} + ImRect(float x1, float y1, float x2, float y2) : Min(x1, y1), Max(x2, y2) {} + + ImVec2 GetCenter() const { return ImVec2((Min.x + Max.x) * 0.5f, (Min.y + Max.y) * 0.5f); } + ImVec2 GetSize() const { return ImVec2(Max.x - Min.x, Max.y - Min.y); } + float GetWidth() const { return Max.x - Min.x; } + float GetHeight() const { return Max.y - Min.y; } + float GetArea() const { return (Max.x - Min.x) * (Max.y - Min.y); } + ImVec2 GetTL() const { return Min; } // Top-left + ImVec2 GetTR() const { return ImVec2(Max.x, Min.y); } // Top-right + ImVec2 GetBL() const { return ImVec2(Min.x, Max.y); } // Bottom-left + ImVec2 GetBR() const { return Max; } // Bottom-right + bool Contains(const ImVec2& p) const { return p.x >= Min.x && p.y >= Min.y && p.x < Max.x && p.y < Max.y; } + bool Contains(const ImRect& r) const { return r.Min.x >= Min.x && r.Min.y >= Min.y && r.Max.x <= Max.x && r.Max.y <= Max.y; } + bool Overlaps(const ImRect& r) const { return r.Min.y < Max.y && r.Max.y > Min.y && r.Min.x < Max.x && r.Max.x > Min.x; } + void Add(const ImVec2& p) { if (Min.x > p.x) Min.x = p.x; if (Min.y > p.y) Min.y = p.y; if (Max.x < p.x) Max.x = p.x; if (Max.y < p.y) Max.y = p.y; } + void Add(const ImRect& r) { if (Min.x > r.Min.x) Min.x = r.Min.x; if (Min.y > r.Min.y) Min.y = r.Min.y; if (Max.x < r.Max.x) Max.x = r.Max.x; if (Max.y < r.Max.y) Max.y = r.Max.y; } + void Expand(const float amount) { Min.x -= amount; Min.y -= amount; Max.x += amount; Max.y += amount; } + void Expand(const ImVec2& amount) { Min.x -= amount.x; Min.y -= amount.y; Max.x += amount.x; Max.y += amount.y; } + void Translate(const ImVec2& d) { Min.x += d.x; Min.y += d.y; Max.x += d.x; Max.y += d.y; } + void TranslateX(float dx) { Min.x += dx; Max.x += dx; } + void TranslateY(float dy) { Min.y += dy; Max.y += dy; } + void ClipWith(const ImRect& r) { Min = ImMax(Min, r.Min); Max = ImMin(Max, r.Max); } // Simple version, may lead to an inverted rectangle, which is fine for Contains/Overlaps test but not for display. + void ClipWithFull(const ImRect& r) { Min = ImClamp(Min, r.Min, r.Max); Max = ImClamp(Max, r.Min, r.Max); } // Full version, ensure both points are fully clipped. + void Floor() { Min.x = IM_FLOOR(Min.x); Min.y = IM_FLOOR(Min.y); Max.x = IM_FLOOR(Max.x); Max.y = IM_FLOOR(Max.y); } + bool IsInverted() const { return Min.x > Max.x || Min.y > Max.y; } + ImVec4 ToVec4() const { return ImVec4(Min.x, Min.y, Max.x, Max.y); } +}; +IM_MSVC_RUNTIME_CHECKS_RESTORE + +// Helper: ImBitArray +inline bool ImBitArrayTestBit(const ImU32* arr, int n) { ImU32 mask = (ImU32)1 << (n & 31); return (arr[n >> 5] & mask) != 0; } +inline void ImBitArrayClearBit(ImU32* arr, int n) { ImU32 mask = (ImU32)1 << (n & 31); arr[n >> 5] &= ~mask; } +inline void ImBitArraySetBit(ImU32* arr, int n) { ImU32 mask = (ImU32)1 << (n & 31); arr[n >> 5] |= mask; } +inline void ImBitArraySetBitRange(ImU32* arr, int n, int n2) // Works on range [n..n2) +{ + n2--; + while (n <= n2) + { + int a_mod = (n & 31); + int b_mod = (n2 > (n | 31) ? 31 : (n2 & 31)) + 1; + ImU32 mask = (ImU32)(((ImU64)1 << b_mod) - 1) & ~(ImU32)(((ImU64)1 << a_mod) - 1); + arr[n >> 5] |= mask; + n = (n + 32) & ~31; + } +} + +// Helper: ImBitArray class (wrapper over ImBitArray functions) +// Store 1-bit per value. +template +struct IMGUI_API ImBitArray +{ + ImU32 Storage[(BITCOUNT + 31) >> 5]; + ImBitArray() { ClearAllBits(); } + void ClearAllBits() { memset(Storage, 0, sizeof(Storage)); } + void SetAllBits() { memset(Storage, 255, sizeof(Storage)); } + bool TestBit(int n) const { IM_ASSERT(n < BITCOUNT); return ImBitArrayTestBit(Storage, n); } + void SetBit(int n) { IM_ASSERT(n < BITCOUNT); ImBitArraySetBit(Storage, n); } + void ClearBit(int n) { IM_ASSERT(n < BITCOUNT); ImBitArrayClearBit(Storage, n); } + void SetBitRange(int n, int n2) { ImBitArraySetBitRange(Storage, n, n2); } // Works on range [n..n2) +}; + +// Helper: ImBitVector +// Store 1-bit per value. +struct IMGUI_API ImBitVector +{ + ImVector Storage; + void Create(int sz) { Storage.resize((sz + 31) >> 5); memset(Storage.Data, 0, (size_t)Storage.Size * sizeof(Storage.Data[0])); } + void Clear() { Storage.clear(); } + bool TestBit(int n) const { IM_ASSERT(n < (Storage.Size << 5)); return ImBitArrayTestBit(Storage.Data, n); } + void SetBit(int n) { IM_ASSERT(n < (Storage.Size << 5)); ImBitArraySetBit(Storage.Data, n); } + void ClearBit(int n) { IM_ASSERT(n < (Storage.Size << 5)); ImBitArrayClearBit(Storage.Data, n); } +}; + +// Helper: ImSpan<> +// Pointing to a span of data we don't own. +template +struct ImSpan +{ + T* Data; + T* DataEnd; + + // Constructors, destructor + inline ImSpan() { Data = DataEnd = NULL; } + inline ImSpan(T* data, int size) { Data = data; DataEnd = data + size; } + inline ImSpan(T* data, T* data_end) { Data = data; DataEnd = data_end; } + + inline void set(T* data, int size) { Data = data; DataEnd = data + size; } + inline void set(T* data, T* data_end) { Data = data; DataEnd = data_end; } + inline int size() const { return (int)(ptrdiff_t)(DataEnd - Data); } + inline int size_in_bytes() const { return (int)(ptrdiff_t)(DataEnd - Data) * (int)sizeof(T); } + inline T& operator[](int i) { T* p = Data + i; IM_ASSERT(p >= Data && p < DataEnd); return *p; } + inline const T& operator[](int i) const { const T* p = Data + i; IM_ASSERT(p >= Data && p < DataEnd); return *p; } + + inline T* begin() { return Data; } + inline const T* begin() const { return Data; } + inline T* end() { return DataEnd; } + inline const T* end() const { return DataEnd; } + + // Utilities + inline int index_from_ptr(const T* it) const { IM_ASSERT(it >= Data && it < DataEnd); const ptrdiff_t off = it - Data; return (int)off; } +}; + +// Helper: ImSpanAllocator<> +// Facilitate storing multiple chunks into a single large block (the "arena") +// - Usage: call Reserve() N times, allocate GetArenaSizeInBytes() worth, pass it to SetArenaBasePtr(), call GetSpan() N times to retrieve the aligned ranges. +template +struct ImSpanAllocator +{ + char* BasePtr; + int CurrOff; + int CurrIdx; + int Offsets[CHUNKS]; + int Sizes[CHUNKS]; + + ImSpanAllocator() { memset(this, 0, sizeof(*this)); } + inline void Reserve(int n, size_t sz, int a=4) { IM_ASSERT(n == CurrIdx && n < CHUNKS); CurrOff = IM_MEMALIGN(CurrOff, a); Offsets[n] = CurrOff; Sizes[n] = (int)sz; CurrIdx++; CurrOff += (int)sz; } + inline int GetArenaSizeInBytes() { return CurrOff; } + inline void SetArenaBasePtr(void* base_ptr) { BasePtr = (char*)base_ptr; } + inline void* GetSpanPtrBegin(int n) { IM_ASSERT(n >= 0 && n < CHUNKS && CurrIdx == CHUNKS); return (void*)(BasePtr + Offsets[n]); } + inline void* GetSpanPtrEnd(int n) { IM_ASSERT(n >= 0 && n < CHUNKS && CurrIdx == CHUNKS); return (void*)(BasePtr + Offsets[n] + Sizes[n]); } + template + inline void GetSpan(int n, ImSpan* span) { span->set((T*)GetSpanPtrBegin(n), (T*)GetSpanPtrEnd(n)); } +}; + +// Helper: ImPool<> +// Basic keyed storage for contiguous instances, slow/amortized insertion, O(1) indexable, O(Log N) queries by ID over a dense/hot buffer, +// Honor constructor/destructor. Add/remove invalidate all pointers. Indexes have the same lifetime as the associated object. +typedef int ImPoolIdx; +template +struct IMGUI_API ImPool +{ + ImVector Buf; // Contiguous data + ImGuiStorage Map; // ID->Index + ImPoolIdx FreeIdx; // Next free idx to use + ImPoolIdx AliveCount; // Number of active/alive items (for display purpose) + + ImPool() { FreeIdx = AliveCount = 0; } + ~ImPool() { Clear(); } + T* GetByKey(ImGuiID key) { int idx = Map.GetInt(key, -1); return (idx != -1) ? &Buf[idx] : NULL; } + T* GetByIndex(ImPoolIdx n) { return &Buf[n]; } + ImPoolIdx GetIndex(const T* p) const { IM_ASSERT(p >= Buf.Data && p < Buf.Data + Buf.Size); return (ImPoolIdx)(p - Buf.Data); } + T* GetOrAddByKey(ImGuiID key) { int* p_idx = Map.GetIntRef(key, -1); if (*p_idx != -1) return &Buf[*p_idx]; *p_idx = FreeIdx; return Add(); } + bool Contains(const T* p) const { return (p >= Buf.Data && p < Buf.Data + Buf.Size); } + void Clear() { for (int n = 0; n < Map.Data.Size; n++) { int idx = Map.Data[n].val_i; if (idx != -1) Buf[idx].~T(); } Map.Clear(); Buf.clear(); FreeIdx = AliveCount = 0; } + T* Add() { int idx = FreeIdx; if (idx == Buf.Size) { Buf.resize(Buf.Size + 1); FreeIdx++; } else { FreeIdx = *(int*)&Buf[idx]; } IM_PLACEMENT_NEW(&Buf[idx]) T(); AliveCount++; return &Buf[idx]; } + void Remove(ImGuiID key, const T* p) { Remove(key, GetIndex(p)); } + void Remove(ImGuiID key, ImPoolIdx idx) { Buf[idx].~T(); *(int*)&Buf[idx] = FreeIdx; FreeIdx = idx; Map.SetInt(key, -1); AliveCount--; } + void Reserve(int capacity) { Buf.reserve(capacity); Map.Data.reserve(capacity); } + + // To iterate a ImPool: for (int n = 0; n < pool.GetMapSize(); n++) if (T* t = pool.TryGetMapData(n)) { ... } + // Can be avoided if you know .Remove() has never been called on the pool, or AliveCount == GetMapSize() + int GetAliveCount() const { return AliveCount; } // Number of active/alive items in the pool (for display purpose) + int GetBufSize() const { return Buf.Size; } + int GetMapSize() const { return Map.Data.Size; } // It is the map we need iterate to find valid items, since we don't have "alive" storage anywhere + T* TryGetMapData(ImPoolIdx n) { int idx = Map.Data[n].val_i; if (idx == -1) return NULL; return GetByIndex(idx); } +#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_OBSOLETE_FUNCTIONS + int GetSize() { return GetMapSize(); } // For ImPlot: should use GetMapSize() from (IMGUI_VERSION_NUM >= 18304) +#endif +}; + +// Helper: ImChunkStream<> +// Build and iterate a contiguous stream of variable-sized structures. +// This is used by Settings to store persistent data while reducing allocation count. +// We store the chunk size first, and align the final size on 4 bytes boundaries. +// The tedious/zealous amount of casting is to avoid -Wcast-align warnings. +template +struct IMGUI_API ImChunkStream +{ + ImVector Buf; + + void clear() { Buf.clear(); } + bool empty() const { return Buf.Size == 0; } + int size() const { return Buf.Size; } + T* alloc_chunk(size_t sz) { size_t HDR_SZ = 4; sz = IM_MEMALIGN(HDR_SZ + sz, 4u); int off = Buf.Size; Buf.resize(off + (int)sz); ((int*)(void*)(Buf.Data + off))[0] = (int)sz; return (T*)(void*)(Buf.Data + off + (int)HDR_SZ); } + T* begin() { size_t HDR_SZ = 4; if (!Buf.Data) return NULL; return (T*)(void*)(Buf.Data + HDR_SZ); } + T* next_chunk(T* p) { size_t HDR_SZ = 4; IM_ASSERT(p >= begin() && p < end()); p = (T*)(void*)((char*)(void*)p + chunk_size(p)); if (p == (T*)(void*)((char*)end() + HDR_SZ)) return (T*)0; IM_ASSERT(p < end()); return p; } + int chunk_size(const T* p) { return ((const int*)p)[-1]; } + T* end() { return (T*)(void*)(Buf.Data + Buf.Size); } + int offset_from_ptr(const T* p) { IM_ASSERT(p >= begin() && p < end()); const ptrdiff_t off = (const char*)p - Buf.Data; return (int)off; } + T* ptr_from_offset(int off) { IM_ASSERT(off >= 4 && off < Buf.Size); return (T*)(void*)(Buf.Data + off); } + void swap(ImChunkStream& rhs) { rhs.Buf.swap(Buf); } + +}; + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] ImDrawList support +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// ImDrawList: Helper function to calculate a circle's segment count given its radius and a "maximum error" value. +// Estimation of number of circle segment based on error is derived using method described in https://stackoverflow.com/a/2244088/15194693 +// Number of segments (N) is calculated using equation: +// N = ceil ( pi / acos(1 - error / r) ) where r > 0, error <= r +// Our equation is significantly simpler that one in the post thanks for choosing segment that is +// perpendicular to X axis. Follow steps in the article from this starting condition and you will +// will get this result. +// +// Rendering circles with an odd number of segments, while mathematically correct will produce +// asymmetrical results on the raster grid. Therefore we're rounding N to next even number (7->8, 8->8, 9->10 etc.) +// +#define IM_ROUNDUP_TO_EVEN(_V) ((((_V) + 1) / 2) * 2) +#define IM_DRAWLIST_CIRCLE_AUTO_SEGMENT_MIN 4 +#define IM_DRAWLIST_CIRCLE_AUTO_SEGMENT_MAX 512 +#define IM_DRAWLIST_CIRCLE_AUTO_SEGMENT_CALC(_RAD,_MAXERROR) ImClamp(IM_ROUNDUP_TO_EVEN((int)ImCeil(IM_PI / ImAcos(1 - ImMin((_MAXERROR), (_RAD)) / (_RAD)))), IM_DRAWLIST_CIRCLE_AUTO_SEGMENT_MIN, IM_DRAWLIST_CIRCLE_AUTO_SEGMENT_MAX) + +// Raw equation from IM_DRAWLIST_CIRCLE_AUTO_SEGMENT_CALC rewritten for 'r' and 'error'. +#define IM_DRAWLIST_CIRCLE_AUTO_SEGMENT_CALC_R(_N,_MAXERROR) ((_MAXERROR) / (1 - ImCos(IM_PI / ImMax((float)(_N), IM_PI)))) +#define IM_DRAWLIST_CIRCLE_AUTO_SEGMENT_CALC_ERROR(_N,_RAD) ((1 - ImCos(IM_PI / ImMax((float)(_N), IM_PI))) / (_RAD)) + +// ImDrawList: Lookup table size for adaptive arc drawing, cover full circle. +#ifndef IM_DRAWLIST_ARCFAST_TABLE_SIZE +#define IM_DRAWLIST_ARCFAST_TABLE_SIZE 48 // Number of samples in lookup table. +#endif +#define IM_DRAWLIST_ARCFAST_SAMPLE_MAX IM_DRAWLIST_ARCFAST_TABLE_SIZE // Sample index _PathArcToFastEx() for 360 angle. + +// Data shared between all ImDrawList instances +// You may want to create your own instance of this if you want to use ImDrawList completely without ImGui. In that case, watch out for future changes to this structure. +struct IMGUI_API ImDrawListSharedData +{ + ImVec2 TexUvWhitePixel; // UV of white pixel in the atlas + ImFont* Font; // Current/default font (optional, for simplified AddText overload) + float FontSize; // Current/default font size (optional, for simplified AddText overload) + float CurveTessellationTol; // Tessellation tolerance when using PathBezierCurveTo() + float CircleSegmentMaxError; // Number of circle segments to use per pixel of radius for AddCircle() etc + ImVec4 ClipRectFullscreen; // Value for PushClipRectFullscreen() + ImDrawListFlags InitialFlags; // Initial flags at the beginning of the frame (it is possible to alter flags on a per-drawlist basis afterwards) + + // [Internal] Lookup tables + ImVec2 ArcFastVtx[IM_DRAWLIST_ARCFAST_TABLE_SIZE]; // Sample points on the quarter of the circle. + float ArcFastRadiusCutoff; // Cutoff radius after which arc drawing will fallback to slower PathArcTo() + ImU8 CircleSegmentCounts[64]; // Precomputed segment count for given radius before we calculate it dynamically (to avoid calculation overhead) + const ImVec4* TexUvLines; // UV of anti-aliased lines in the atlas + + ImDrawListSharedData(); + void SetCircleTessellationMaxError(float max_error); +}; + +struct ImDrawDataBuilder +{ + ImVector Layers[2]; // Global layers for: regular, tooltip + + void Clear() { for (int n = 0; n < IM_ARRAYSIZE(Layers); n++) Layers[n].resize(0); } + void ClearFreeMemory() { for (int n = 0; n < IM_ARRAYSIZE(Layers); n++) Layers[n].clear(); } + int GetDrawListCount() const { int count = 0; for (int n = 0; n < IM_ARRAYSIZE(Layers); n++) count += Layers[n].Size; return count; } + IMGUI_API void FlattenIntoSingleLayer(); +}; + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Widgets support: flags, enums, data structures +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// Transient per-window flags, reset at the beginning of the frame. For child window, inherited from parent on first Begin(). +// This is going to be exposed in imgui.h when stabilized enough. +enum ImGuiItemFlags_ +{ + ImGuiItemFlags_None = 0, + ImGuiItemFlags_NoTabStop = 1 << 0, // false // Disable keyboard tabbing (FIXME: should merge with _NoNav) + ImGuiItemFlags_ButtonRepeat = 1 << 1, // false // Button() will return true multiple times based on io.KeyRepeatDelay and io.KeyRepeatRate settings. + ImGuiItemFlags_Disabled = 1 << 2, // false // Disable interactions but doesn't affect visuals. See BeginDisabled()/EndDisabled(). See github.com/ocornut/imgui/issues/211 + ImGuiItemFlags_NoNav = 1 << 3, // false // Disable keyboard/gamepad directional navigation (FIXME: should merge with _NoTabStop) + ImGuiItemFlags_NoNavDefaultFocus = 1 << 4, // false // Disable item being a candidate for default focus (e.g. used by title bar items) + ImGuiItemFlags_SelectableDontClosePopup = 1 << 5, // false // Disable MenuItem/Selectable() automatically closing their popup window + ImGuiItemFlags_MixedValue = 1 << 6, // false // [BETA] Represent a mixed/indeterminate value, generally multi-selection where values differ. Currently only supported by Checkbox() (later should support all sorts of widgets) + ImGuiItemFlags_ReadOnly = 1 << 7 // false // [ALPHA] Allow hovering interactions but underlying value is not changed. +}; + +// Flags for ItemAdd() +// FIXME-NAV: _Focusable is _ALMOST_ what you would expect to be called '_TabStop' but because SetKeyboardFocusHere() works on items with no TabStop we distinguish Focusable from TabStop. +enum ImGuiItemAddFlags_ +{ + ImGuiItemAddFlags_None = 0, + ImGuiItemAddFlags_Focusable = 1 << 0 // FIXME-NAV: In current/legacy scheme, Focusable+TabStop support are opt-in by widgets. We will transition it toward being opt-out, so this flag is expected to eventually disappear. +}; + +// Storage for LastItem data +enum ImGuiItemStatusFlags_ +{ + ImGuiItemStatusFlags_None = 0, + ImGuiItemStatusFlags_HoveredRect = 1 << 0, // Mouse position is within item rectangle (does NOT mean that the window is in correct z-order and can be hovered!, this is only one part of the most-common IsItemHovered test) + ImGuiItemStatusFlags_HasDisplayRect = 1 << 1, // window->DC.LastItemDisplayRect is valid + ImGuiItemStatusFlags_Edited = 1 << 2, // Value exposed by item was edited in the current frame (should match the bool return value of most widgets) + ImGuiItemStatusFlags_ToggledSelection = 1 << 3, // Set when Selectable(), TreeNode() reports toggling a selection. We can't report "Selected", only state changes, in order to easily handle clipping with less issues. + ImGuiItemStatusFlags_ToggledOpen = 1 << 4, // Set when TreeNode() reports toggling their open state. + ImGuiItemStatusFlags_HasDeactivated = 1 << 5, // Set if the widget/group is able to provide data for the ImGuiItemStatusFlags_Deactivated flag. + ImGuiItemStatusFlags_Deactivated = 1 << 6, // Only valid if ImGuiItemStatusFlags_HasDeactivated is set. + ImGuiItemStatusFlags_HoveredWindow = 1 << 7, // Override the HoveredWindow test to allow cross-window hover testing. + ImGuiItemStatusFlags_FocusedByCode = 1 << 8, // Set when the Focusable item just got focused from code. + ImGuiItemStatusFlags_FocusedByTabbing = 1 << 9, // Set when the Focusable item just got focused by Tabbing. + ImGuiItemStatusFlags_Focused = ImGuiItemStatusFlags_FocusedByCode | ImGuiItemStatusFlags_FocusedByTabbing + +#ifdef IMGUI_ENABLE_TEST_ENGINE + , // [imgui_tests only] + ImGuiItemStatusFlags_Openable = 1 << 20, // + ImGuiItemStatusFlags_Opened = 1 << 21, // + ImGuiItemStatusFlags_Checkable = 1 << 22, // + ImGuiItemStatusFlags_Checked = 1 << 23 // +#endif +}; + +// Extend ImGuiInputTextFlags_ +enum ImGuiInputTextFlagsPrivate_ +{ + // [Internal] + ImGuiInputTextFlags_Multiline = 1 << 26, // For internal use by InputTextMultiline() + ImGuiInputTextFlags_NoMarkEdited = 1 << 27, // For internal use by functions using InputText() before reformatting data + ImGuiInputTextFlags_MergedItem = 1 << 28 // For internal use by TempInputText(), will skip calling ItemAdd(). Require bounding-box to strictly match. +}; + +// Extend ImGuiButtonFlags_ +enum ImGuiButtonFlagsPrivate_ +{ + ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClick = 1 << 4, // return true on click (mouse down event) + ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClickRelease = 1 << 5, // [Default] return true on click + release on same item <-- this is what the majority of Button are using + ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClickReleaseAnywhere = 1 << 6, // return true on click + release even if the release event is not done while hovering the item + ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnRelease = 1 << 7, // return true on release (default requires click+release) + ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnDoubleClick = 1 << 8, // return true on double-click (default requires click+release) + ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnDragDropHold = 1 << 9, // return true when held into while we are drag and dropping another item (used by e.g. tree nodes, collapsing headers) + ImGuiButtonFlags_Repeat = 1 << 10, // hold to repeat + ImGuiButtonFlags_FlattenChildren = 1 << 11, // allow interactions even if a child window is overlapping + ImGuiButtonFlags_AllowItemOverlap = 1 << 12, // require previous frame HoveredId to either match id or be null before being usable, use along with SetItemAllowOverlap() + ImGuiButtonFlags_DontClosePopups = 1 << 13, // disable automatically closing parent popup on press // [UNUSED] + //ImGuiButtonFlags_Disabled = 1 << 14, // disable interactions -> use BeginDisabled() or ImGuiItemFlags_Disabled + ImGuiButtonFlags_AlignTextBaseLine = 1 << 15, // vertically align button to match text baseline - ButtonEx() only // FIXME: Should be removed and handled by SmallButton(), not possible currently because of DC.CursorPosPrevLine + ImGuiButtonFlags_NoKeyModifiers = 1 << 16, // disable mouse interaction if a key modifier is held + ImGuiButtonFlags_NoHoldingActiveId = 1 << 17, // don't set ActiveId while holding the mouse (ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClick only) + ImGuiButtonFlags_NoNavFocus = 1 << 18, // don't override navigation focus when activated + ImGuiButtonFlags_NoHoveredOnFocus = 1 << 19, // don't report as hovered when nav focus is on this item + ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnMask_ = ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClick | ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClickRelease | ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClickReleaseAnywhere | ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnRelease | ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnDoubleClick | ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnDragDropHold, + ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnDefault_ = ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClickRelease +}; + +// Extend ImGuiComboFlags_ +enum ImGuiComboFlagsPrivate_ +{ + ImGuiComboFlags_CustomPreview = 1 << 20 // enable BeginComboPreview() +}; + +// Extend ImGuiSliderFlags_ +enum ImGuiSliderFlagsPrivate_ +{ + ImGuiSliderFlags_Vertical = 1 << 20, // Should this slider be orientated vertically? + ImGuiSliderFlags_ReadOnly = 1 << 21 +}; + +// Extend ImGuiSelectableFlags_ +enum ImGuiSelectableFlagsPrivate_ +{ + // NB: need to be in sync with last value of ImGuiSelectableFlags_ + ImGuiSelectableFlags_NoHoldingActiveID = 1 << 20, + ImGuiSelectableFlags_SelectOnNav = 1 << 21, // (WIP) Auto-select when moved into. This is not exposed in public API as to handle multi-select and modifiers we will need user to explicitly control focus scope. May be replaced with a BeginSelection() API. + ImGuiSelectableFlags_SelectOnClick = 1 << 22, // Override button behavior to react on Click (default is Click+Release) + ImGuiSelectableFlags_SelectOnRelease = 1 << 23, // Override button behavior to react on Release (default is Click+Release) + ImGuiSelectableFlags_SpanAvailWidth = 1 << 24, // Span all avail width even if we declared less for layout purpose. FIXME: We may be able to remove this (added in 6251d379, 2bcafc86 for menus) + ImGuiSelectableFlags_DrawHoveredWhenHeld = 1 << 25, // Always show active when held, even is not hovered. This concept could probably be renamed/formalized somehow. + ImGuiSelectableFlags_SetNavIdOnHover = 1 << 26, // Set Nav/Focus ID on mouse hover (used by MenuItem) + ImGuiSelectableFlags_NoPadWithHalfSpacing = 1 << 27 // Disable padding each side with ItemSpacing * 0.5f +}; + +// Extend ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_ +enum ImGuiTreeNodeFlagsPrivate_ +{ + ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_ClipLabelForTrailingButton = 1 << 20 +}; + +enum ImGuiSeparatorFlags_ +{ + ImGuiSeparatorFlags_None = 0, + ImGuiSeparatorFlags_Horizontal = 1 << 0, // Axis default to current layout type, so generally Horizontal unless e.g. in a menu bar + ImGuiSeparatorFlags_Vertical = 1 << 1, + ImGuiSeparatorFlags_SpanAllColumns = 1 << 2 +}; + +enum ImGuiTextFlags_ +{ + ImGuiTextFlags_None = 0, + ImGuiTextFlags_NoWidthForLargeClippedText = 1 << 0 +}; + +enum ImGuiTooltipFlags_ +{ + ImGuiTooltipFlags_None = 0, + ImGuiTooltipFlags_OverridePreviousTooltip = 1 << 0 // Override will clear/ignore previously submitted tooltip (defaults to append) +}; + +// FIXME: this is in development, not exposed/functional as a generic feature yet. +// Horizontal/Vertical enums are fixed to 0/1 so they may be used to index ImVec2 +enum ImGuiLayoutType_ +{ + ImGuiLayoutType_Horizontal = 0, + ImGuiLayoutType_Vertical = 1 +}; + +enum ImGuiLogType +{ + ImGuiLogType_None = 0, + ImGuiLogType_TTY, + ImGuiLogType_File, + ImGuiLogType_Buffer, + ImGuiLogType_Clipboard +}; + +// X/Y enums are fixed to 0/1 so they may be used to index ImVec2 +enum ImGuiAxis +{ + ImGuiAxis_None = -1, + ImGuiAxis_X = 0, + ImGuiAxis_Y = 1 +}; + +enum ImGuiPlotType +{ + ImGuiPlotType_Lines, + ImGuiPlotType_Histogram +}; + +enum ImGuiInputSource +{ + ImGuiInputSource_None = 0, + ImGuiInputSource_Mouse, + ImGuiInputSource_Keyboard, + ImGuiInputSource_Gamepad, + ImGuiInputSource_Nav, // Stored in g.ActiveIdSource only + ImGuiInputSource_Clipboard, // Currently only used by InputText() + ImGuiInputSource_COUNT +}; + +// FIXME-NAV: Clarify/expose various repeat delay/rate +enum ImGuiInputReadMode +{ + ImGuiInputReadMode_Down, + ImGuiInputReadMode_Pressed, + ImGuiInputReadMode_Released, + ImGuiInputReadMode_Repeat, + ImGuiInputReadMode_RepeatSlow, + ImGuiInputReadMode_RepeatFast +}; + +enum ImGuiNavHighlightFlags_ +{ + ImGuiNavHighlightFlags_None = 0, + ImGuiNavHighlightFlags_TypeDefault = 1 << 0, + ImGuiNavHighlightFlags_TypeThin = 1 << 1, + ImGuiNavHighlightFlags_AlwaysDraw = 1 << 2, // Draw rectangular highlight if (g.NavId == id) _even_ when using the mouse. + ImGuiNavHighlightFlags_NoRounding = 1 << 3 +}; + +enum ImGuiNavDirSourceFlags_ +{ + ImGuiNavDirSourceFlags_None = 0, + ImGuiNavDirSourceFlags_Keyboard = 1 << 0, + ImGuiNavDirSourceFlags_PadDPad = 1 << 1, + ImGuiNavDirSourceFlags_PadLStick = 1 << 2 +}; + +enum ImGuiNavMoveFlags_ +{ + ImGuiNavMoveFlags_None = 0, + ImGuiNavMoveFlags_LoopX = 1 << 0, // On failed request, restart from opposite side + ImGuiNavMoveFlags_LoopY = 1 << 1, + ImGuiNavMoveFlags_WrapX = 1 << 2, // On failed request, request from opposite side one line down (when NavDir==right) or one line up (when NavDir==left) + ImGuiNavMoveFlags_WrapY = 1 << 3, // This is not super useful for provided for completeness + ImGuiNavMoveFlags_AllowCurrentNavId = 1 << 4, // Allow scoring and considering the current NavId as a move target candidate. This is used when the move source is offset (e.g. pressing PageDown actually needs to send a Up move request, if we are pressing PageDown from the bottom-most item we need to stay in place) + ImGuiNavMoveFlags_AlsoScoreVisibleSet = 1 << 5, // Store alternate result in NavMoveResultLocalVisibleSet that only comprise elements that are already fully visible. + ImGuiNavMoveFlags_ScrollToEdge = 1 << 6 +}; + +enum ImGuiNavForward +{ + ImGuiNavForward_None, + ImGuiNavForward_ForwardQueued, + ImGuiNavForward_ForwardActive +}; + +enum ImGuiNavLayer +{ + ImGuiNavLayer_Main = 0, // Main scrolling layer + ImGuiNavLayer_Menu = 1, // Menu layer (access with Alt/ImGuiNavInput_Menu) + ImGuiNavLayer_COUNT +}; + +enum ImGuiPopupPositionPolicy +{ + ImGuiPopupPositionPolicy_Default, + ImGuiPopupPositionPolicy_ComboBox, + ImGuiPopupPositionPolicy_Tooltip +}; + +struct ImGuiDataTypeTempStorage +{ + ImU8 Data[8]; // Can fit any data up to ImGuiDataType_COUNT +}; + +// Type information associated to one ImGuiDataType. Retrieve with DataTypeGetInfo(). +struct ImGuiDataTypeInfo +{ + size_t Size; // Size in bytes + const char* Name; // Short descriptive name for the type, for debugging + const char* PrintFmt; // Default printf format for the type + const char* ScanFmt; // Default scanf format for the type +}; + +// Extend ImGuiDataType_ +enum ImGuiDataTypePrivate_ +{ + ImGuiDataType_String = ImGuiDataType_COUNT + 1, + ImGuiDataType_Pointer, + ImGuiDataType_ID +}; + +// Stacked color modifier, backup of modified data so we can restore it +struct ImGuiColorMod +{ + ImGuiCol Col; + ImVec4 BackupValue; +}; + +// Stacked style modifier, backup of modified data so we can restore it. Data type inferred from the variable. +struct ImGuiStyleMod +{ + ImGuiStyleVar VarIdx; + union { int BackupInt[2]; float BackupFloat[2]; }; + ImGuiStyleMod(ImGuiStyleVar idx, int v) { VarIdx = idx; BackupInt[0] = v; } + ImGuiStyleMod(ImGuiStyleVar idx, float v) { VarIdx = idx; BackupFloat[0] = v; } + ImGuiStyleMod(ImGuiStyleVar idx, ImVec2 v) { VarIdx = idx; BackupFloat[0] = v.x; BackupFloat[1] = v.y; } +}; + +// Storage data for BeginComboPreview()/EndComboPreview() +struct IMGUI_API ImGuiComboPreviewData +{ + ImRect PreviewRect; + ImVec2 BackupCursorPos; + ImVec2 BackupCursorMaxPos; + ImVec2 BackupCursorPosPrevLine; + float BackupPrevLineTextBaseOffset; + ImGuiLayoutType BackupLayout; + + ImGuiComboPreviewData() { memset(this, 0, sizeof(*this)); } +}; + +// Stacked storage data for BeginGroup()/EndGroup() +struct IMGUI_API ImGuiGroupData +{ + ImGuiID WindowID; + ImVec2 BackupCursorPos; + ImVec2 BackupCursorMaxPos; + ImVec1 BackupIndent; + ImVec1 BackupGroupOffset; + ImVec2 BackupCurrLineSize; + float BackupCurrLineTextBaseOffset; + ImGuiID BackupActiveIdIsAlive; + bool BackupActiveIdPreviousFrameIsAlive; + bool BackupHoveredIdIsAlive; + bool EmitItem; +}; + +// Simple column measurement, currently used for MenuItem() only.. This is very short-sighted/throw-away code and NOT a generic helper. +struct IMGUI_API ImGuiMenuColumns +{ + ImU32 TotalWidth; + ImU32 NextTotalWidth; + ImU16 Spacing; + ImU16 OffsetIcon; // Always zero for now + ImU16 OffsetLabel; // Offsets are locked in Update() + ImU16 OffsetShortcut; + ImU16 OffsetMark; + ImU16 Widths[4]; // Width of: Icon, Label, Shortcut, Mark (accumulators for current frame) + + ImGuiMenuColumns() { memset(this, 0, sizeof(*this)); } + void Update(float spacing, bool window_reappearing); + float DeclColumns(float w_icon, float w_label, float w_shortcut, float w_mark); + void CalcNextTotalWidth(bool update_offsets); +}; + +// Internal state of the currently focused/edited text input box +// For a given item ID, access with ImGui::GetInputTextState() +struct IMGUI_API ImGuiInputTextState +{ + ImGuiID ID; // widget id owning the text state + int CurLenW, CurLenA; // we need to maintain our buffer length in both UTF-8 and wchar format. UTF-8 length is valid even if TextA is not. + ImVector TextW; // edit buffer, we need to persist but can't guarantee the persistence of the user-provided buffer. so we copy into own buffer. + ImVector TextA; // temporary UTF8 buffer for callbacks and other operations. this is not updated in every code-path! size=capacity. + ImVector InitialTextA; // backup of end-user buffer at the time of focus (in UTF-8, unaltered) + bool TextAIsValid; // temporary UTF8 buffer is not initially valid before we make the widget active (until then we pull the data from user argument) + int BufCapacityA; // end-user buffer capacity + float ScrollX; // horizontal scrolling/offset + ImStb::STB_TexteditState Stb; // state for stb_textedit.h + float CursorAnim; // timer for cursor blink, reset on every user action so the cursor reappears immediately + bool CursorFollow; // set when we want scrolling to follow the current cursor position (not always!) + bool SelectedAllMouseLock; // after a double-click to select all, we ignore further mouse drags to update selection + bool Edited; // edited this frame + ImGuiInputTextFlags Flags; // copy of InputText() flags + ImGuiInputTextCallback UserCallback; // " + void* UserCallbackData; // " + + ImGuiInputTextState() { memset(this, 0, sizeof(*this)); } + void ClearText() { CurLenW = CurLenA = 0; TextW[0] = 0; TextA[0] = 0; CursorClamp(); } + void ClearFreeMemory() { TextW.clear(); TextA.clear(); InitialTextA.clear(); } + int GetUndoAvailCount() const { return Stb.undostate.undo_point; } + int GetRedoAvailCount() const { return STB_TEXTEDIT_UNDOSTATECOUNT - Stb.undostate.redo_point; } + void OnKeyPressed(int key); // Cannot be inline because we call in code in stb_textedit.h implementation + + // Cursor & Selection + void CursorAnimReset() { CursorAnim = -0.30f; } // After a user-input the cursor stays on for a while without blinking + void CursorClamp() { Stb.cursor = ImMin(Stb.cursor, CurLenW); Stb.select_start = ImMin(Stb.select_start, CurLenW); Stb.select_end = ImMin(Stb.select_end, CurLenW); } + bool HasSelection() const { return Stb.select_start != Stb.select_end; } + void ClearSelection() { Stb.select_start = Stb.select_end = Stb.cursor; } + int GetCursorPos() const { return Stb.cursor; } + int GetSelectionStart() const { return Stb.select_start; } + int GetSelectionEnd() const { return Stb.select_end; } + void SelectAll() { Stb.select_start = 0; Stb.cursor = Stb.select_end = CurLenW; Stb.has_preferred_x = 0; } +}; + +// Storage for current popup stack +struct ImGuiPopupData +{ + ImGuiID PopupId; // Set on OpenPopup() + ImGuiWindow* Window; // Resolved on BeginPopup() - may stay unresolved if user never calls OpenPopup() + ImGuiWindow* SourceWindow; // Set on OpenPopup() copy of NavWindow at the time of opening the popup + int OpenFrameCount; // Set on OpenPopup() + ImGuiID OpenParentId; // Set on OpenPopup(), we need this to differentiate multiple menu sets from each others (e.g. inside menu bar vs loose menu items) + ImVec2 OpenPopupPos; // Set on OpenPopup(), preferred popup position (typically == OpenMousePos when using mouse) + ImVec2 OpenMousePos; // Set on OpenPopup(), copy of mouse position at the time of opening popup + + ImGuiPopupData() { memset(this, 0, sizeof(*this)); OpenFrameCount = -1; } +}; + +struct ImGuiNavItemData +{ + ImGuiWindow* Window; // Init,Move // Best candidate window (result->ItemWindow->RootWindowForNav == request->Window) + ImGuiID ID; // Init,Move // Best candidate item ID + ImGuiID FocusScopeId; // Init,Move // Best candidate focus scope ID + ImRect RectRel; // Init,Move // Best candidate bounding box in window relative space + float DistBox; // Move // Best candidate box distance to current NavId + float DistCenter; // Move // Best candidate center distance to current NavId + float DistAxial; // Move // Best candidate axial distance to current NavId + + ImGuiNavItemData() { Clear(); } + void Clear() { Window = NULL; ID = FocusScopeId = 0; RectRel = ImRect(); DistBox = DistCenter = DistAxial = FLT_MAX; } +}; + +enum ImGuiNextWindowDataFlags_ +{ + ImGuiNextWindowDataFlags_None = 0, + ImGuiNextWindowDataFlags_HasPos = 1 << 0, + ImGuiNextWindowDataFlags_HasSize = 1 << 1, + ImGuiNextWindowDataFlags_HasContentSize = 1 << 2, + ImGuiNextWindowDataFlags_HasCollapsed = 1 << 3, + ImGuiNextWindowDataFlags_HasSizeConstraint = 1 << 4, + ImGuiNextWindowDataFlags_HasFocus = 1 << 5, + ImGuiNextWindowDataFlags_HasBgAlpha = 1 << 6, + ImGuiNextWindowDataFlags_HasScroll = 1 << 7 +}; + +// Storage for SetNexWindow** functions +struct ImGuiNextWindowData +{ + ImGuiNextWindowDataFlags Flags; + ImGuiCond PosCond; + ImGuiCond SizeCond; + ImGuiCond CollapsedCond; + ImVec2 PosVal; + ImVec2 PosPivotVal; + ImVec2 SizeVal; + ImVec2 ContentSizeVal; + ImVec2 ScrollVal; + bool CollapsedVal; + ImRect SizeConstraintRect; + ImGuiSizeCallback SizeCallback; + void* SizeCallbackUserData; + float BgAlphaVal; // Override background alpha + ImVec2 MenuBarOffsetMinVal; // (Always on) This is not exposed publicly, so we don't clear it and it doesn't have a corresponding flag (could we? for consistency?) + + ImGuiNextWindowData() { memset(this, 0, sizeof(*this)); } + inline void ClearFlags() { Flags = ImGuiNextWindowDataFlags_None; } +}; + +enum ImGuiNextItemDataFlags_ +{ + ImGuiNextItemDataFlags_None = 0, + ImGuiNextItemDataFlags_HasWidth = 1 << 0, + ImGuiNextItemDataFlags_HasOpen = 1 << 1 +}; + +struct ImGuiNextItemData +{ + ImGuiNextItemDataFlags Flags; + float Width; // Set by SetNextItemWidth() + ImGuiID FocusScopeId; // Set by SetNextItemMultiSelectData() (!= 0 signify value has been set, so it's an alternate version of HasSelectionData, we don't use Flags for this because they are cleared too early. This is mostly used for debugging) + ImGuiCond OpenCond; + bool OpenVal; // Set by SetNextItemOpen() + + ImGuiNextItemData() { memset(this, 0, sizeof(*this)); } + inline void ClearFlags() { Flags = ImGuiNextItemDataFlags_None; } // Also cleared manually by ItemAdd()! +}; + +// Status storage for the last submitted item +struct ImGuiLastItemData +{ + ImGuiID ID; + ImGuiItemFlags InFlags; // See ImGuiItemFlags_ + ImGuiItemStatusFlags StatusFlags; // See ImGuiItemStatusFlags_ + ImRect Rect; + ImRect DisplayRect; + + ImGuiLastItemData() { memset(this, 0, sizeof(*this)); } +}; + +// Data saved for each window pushed into the stack +struct ImGuiWindowStackData +{ + ImGuiWindow* Window; + ImGuiLastItemData ParentLastItemDataBackup; +}; + +struct ImGuiShrinkWidthItem +{ + int Index; + float Width; +}; + +struct ImGuiPtrOrIndex +{ + void* Ptr; // Either field can be set, not both. e.g. Dock node tab bars are loose while BeginTabBar() ones are in a pool. + int Index; // Usually index in a main pool. + + ImGuiPtrOrIndex(void* ptr) { Ptr = ptr; Index = -1; } + ImGuiPtrOrIndex(int index) { Ptr = NULL; Index = index; } +}; + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Columns support +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// Flags for internal's BeginColumns(). Prefix using BeginTable() nowadays! +enum ImGuiOldColumnFlags_ +{ + ImGuiOldColumnFlags_None = 0, + ImGuiOldColumnFlags_NoBorder = 1 << 0, // Disable column dividers + ImGuiOldColumnFlags_NoResize = 1 << 1, // Disable resizing columns when clicking on the dividers + ImGuiOldColumnFlags_NoPreserveWidths = 1 << 2, // Disable column width preservation when adjusting columns + ImGuiOldColumnFlags_NoForceWithinWindow = 1 << 3, // Disable forcing columns to fit within window + ImGuiOldColumnFlags_GrowParentContentsSize = 1 << 4 // (WIP) Restore pre-1.51 behavior of extending the parent window contents size but _without affecting the columns width at all_. Will eventually remove. + + // Obsolete names (will be removed) +#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_OBSOLETE_FUNCTIONS + , ImGuiColumnsFlags_None = ImGuiOldColumnFlags_None, + ImGuiColumnsFlags_NoBorder = ImGuiOldColumnFlags_NoBorder, + ImGuiColumnsFlags_NoResize = ImGuiOldColumnFlags_NoResize, + ImGuiColumnsFlags_NoPreserveWidths = ImGuiOldColumnFlags_NoPreserveWidths, + ImGuiColumnsFlags_NoForceWithinWindow = ImGuiOldColumnFlags_NoForceWithinWindow, + ImGuiColumnsFlags_GrowParentContentsSize = ImGuiOldColumnFlags_GrowParentContentsSize +#endif +}; + +struct ImGuiOldColumnData +{ + float OffsetNorm; // Column start offset, normalized 0.0 (far left) -> 1.0 (far right) + float OffsetNormBeforeResize; + ImGuiOldColumnFlags Flags; // Not exposed + ImRect ClipRect; + + ImGuiOldColumnData() { memset(this, 0, sizeof(*this)); } +}; + +struct ImGuiOldColumns +{ + ImGuiID ID; + ImGuiOldColumnFlags Flags; + bool IsFirstFrame; + bool IsBeingResized; + int Current; + int Count; + float OffMinX, OffMaxX; // Offsets from HostWorkRect.Min.x + float LineMinY, LineMaxY; + float HostCursorPosY; // Backup of CursorPos at the time of BeginColumns() + float HostCursorMaxPosX; // Backup of CursorMaxPos at the time of BeginColumns() + ImRect HostInitialClipRect; // Backup of ClipRect at the time of BeginColumns() + ImRect HostBackupClipRect; // Backup of ClipRect during PushColumnsBackground()/PopColumnsBackground() + ImRect HostBackupParentWorkRect;//Backup of WorkRect at the time of BeginColumns() + ImVector Columns; + ImDrawListSplitter Splitter; + + ImGuiOldColumns() { memset(this, 0, sizeof(*this)); } +}; + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Multi-select support +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +#ifdef IMGUI_HAS_MULTI_SELECT +// +#endif // #ifdef IMGUI_HAS_MULTI_SELECT + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Docking support +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +#ifdef IMGUI_HAS_DOCK +// +#endif // #ifdef IMGUI_HAS_DOCK + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Viewport support +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// ImGuiViewport Private/Internals fields (cardinal sin: we are using inheritance!) +// Every instance of ImGuiViewport is in fact a ImGuiViewportP. +struct ImGuiViewportP : public ImGuiViewport +{ + int DrawListsLastFrame[2]; // Last frame number the background (0) and foreground (1) draw lists were used + ImDrawList* DrawLists[2]; // Convenience background (0) and foreground (1) draw lists. We use them to draw software mouser cursor when io.MouseDrawCursor is set and to draw most debug overlays. + ImDrawData DrawDataP; + ImDrawDataBuilder DrawDataBuilder; + + ImVec2 WorkOffsetMin; // Work Area: Offset from Pos to top-left corner of Work Area. Generally (0,0) or (0,+main_menu_bar_height). Work Area is Full Area but without menu-bars/status-bars (so WorkArea always fit inside Pos/Size!) + ImVec2 WorkOffsetMax; // Work Area: Offset from Pos+Size to bottom-right corner of Work Area. Generally (0,0) or (0,-status_bar_height). + ImVec2 BuildWorkOffsetMin; // Work Area: Offset being built during current frame. Generally >= 0.0f. + ImVec2 BuildWorkOffsetMax; // Work Area: Offset being built during current frame. Generally <= 0.0f. + + ImGuiViewportP() { DrawListsLastFrame[0] = DrawListsLastFrame[1] = -1; DrawLists[0] = DrawLists[1] = NULL; } + ~ImGuiViewportP() { if (DrawLists[0]) IM_DELETE(DrawLists[0]); if (DrawLists[1]) IM_DELETE(DrawLists[1]); } + + // Calculate work rect pos/size given a set of offset (we have 1 pair of offset for rect locked from last frame data, and 1 pair for currently building rect) + ImVec2 CalcWorkRectPos(const ImVec2& off_min) const { return ImVec2(Pos.x + off_min.x, Pos.y + off_min.y); } + ImVec2 CalcWorkRectSize(const ImVec2& off_min, const ImVec2& off_max) const { return ImVec2(ImMax(0.0f, Size.x - off_min.x + off_max.x), ImMax(0.0f, Size.y - off_min.y + off_max.y)); } + void UpdateWorkRect() { WorkPos = CalcWorkRectPos(WorkOffsetMin); WorkSize = CalcWorkRectSize(WorkOffsetMin, WorkOffsetMax); } // Update public fields + + // Helpers to retrieve ImRect (we don't need to store BuildWorkRect as every access tend to change it, hence the code asymmetry) + ImRect GetMainRect() const { return ImRect(Pos.x, Pos.y, Pos.x + Size.x, Pos.y + Size.y); } + ImRect GetWorkRect() const { return ImRect(WorkPos.x, WorkPos.y, WorkPos.x + WorkSize.x, WorkPos.y + WorkSize.y); } + ImRect GetBuildWorkRect() const { ImVec2 pos = CalcWorkRectPos(BuildWorkOffsetMin); ImVec2 size = CalcWorkRectSize(BuildWorkOffsetMin, BuildWorkOffsetMax); return ImRect(pos.x, pos.y, pos.x + size.x, pos.y + size.y); } +}; + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Settings support +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// Windows data saved in imgui.ini file +// Because we never destroy or rename ImGuiWindowSettings, we can store the names in a separate buffer easily. +// (this is designed to be stored in a ImChunkStream buffer, with the variable-length Name following our structure) +struct ImGuiWindowSettings +{ + ImGuiID ID; + ImVec2ih Pos; + ImVec2ih Size; + bool Collapsed; + bool WantApply; // Set when loaded from .ini data (to enable merging/loading .ini data into an already running context) + + ImGuiWindowSettings() { memset(this, 0, sizeof(*this)); } + char* GetName() { return (char*)(this + 1); } +}; + +struct ImGuiSettingsHandler +{ + const char* TypeName; // Short description stored in .ini file. Disallowed characters: '[' ']' + ImGuiID TypeHash; // == ImHashStr(TypeName) + void (*ClearAllFn)(ImGuiContext* ctx, ImGuiSettingsHandler* handler); // Clear all settings data + void (*ReadInitFn)(ImGuiContext* ctx, ImGuiSettingsHandler* handler); // Read: Called before reading (in registration order) + void* (*ReadOpenFn)(ImGuiContext* ctx, ImGuiSettingsHandler* handler, const char* name); // Read: Called when entering into a new ini entry e.g. "[Window][Name]" + void (*ReadLineFn)(ImGuiContext* ctx, ImGuiSettingsHandler* handler, void* entry, const char* line); // Read: Called for every line of text within an ini entry + void (*ApplyAllFn)(ImGuiContext* ctx, ImGuiSettingsHandler* handler); // Read: Called after reading (in registration order) + void (*WriteAllFn)(ImGuiContext* ctx, ImGuiSettingsHandler* handler, ImGuiTextBuffer* out_buf); // Write: Output every entries into 'out_buf' + void* UserData; + + ImGuiSettingsHandler() { memset(this, 0, sizeof(*this)); } +}; + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Metrics, Debug +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +struct ImGuiMetricsConfig +{ + bool ShowWindowsRects; + bool ShowWindowsBeginOrder; + bool ShowTablesRects; + bool ShowDrawCmdMesh; + bool ShowDrawCmdBoundingBoxes; + int ShowWindowsRectsType; + int ShowTablesRectsType; + + ImGuiMetricsConfig() + { + ShowWindowsRects = false; + ShowWindowsBeginOrder = false; + ShowTablesRects = false; + ShowDrawCmdMesh = true; + ShowDrawCmdBoundingBoxes = true; + ShowWindowsRectsType = -1; + ShowTablesRectsType = -1; + } +}; + +struct IMGUI_API ImGuiStackSizes +{ + short SizeOfIDStack; + short SizeOfColorStack; + short SizeOfStyleVarStack; + short SizeOfFontStack; + short SizeOfFocusScopeStack; + short SizeOfGroupStack; + short SizeOfBeginPopupStack; + + ImGuiStackSizes() { memset(this, 0, sizeof(*this)); } + void SetToCurrentState(); + void CompareWithCurrentState(); +}; + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Generic context hooks +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +typedef void (*ImGuiContextHookCallback)(ImGuiContext* ctx, ImGuiContextHook* hook); +enum ImGuiContextHookType { ImGuiContextHookType_NewFramePre, ImGuiContextHookType_NewFramePost, ImGuiContextHookType_EndFramePre, ImGuiContextHookType_EndFramePost, ImGuiContextHookType_RenderPre, ImGuiContextHookType_RenderPost, ImGuiContextHookType_Shutdown, ImGuiContextHookType_PendingRemoval_ }; + +struct ImGuiContextHook +{ + ImGuiID HookId; // A unique ID assigned by AddContextHook() + ImGuiContextHookType Type; + ImGuiID Owner; + ImGuiContextHookCallback Callback; + void* UserData; + + ImGuiContextHook() { memset(this, 0, sizeof(*this)); } +}; + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] ImGuiContext (main imgui context) +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +struct ImGuiContext +{ + bool Initialized; + bool FontAtlasOwnedByContext; // IO.Fonts-> is owned by the ImGuiContext and will be destructed along with it. + ImGuiIO IO; + ImGuiStyle Style; + ImFont* Font; // (Shortcut) == FontStack.empty() ? IO.Font : FontStack.back() + float FontSize; // (Shortcut) == FontBaseSize * g.CurrentWindow->FontWindowScale == window->FontSize(). Text height for current window. + float FontBaseSize; // (Shortcut) == IO.FontGlobalScale * Font->Scale * Font->FontSize. Base text height. + ImDrawListSharedData DrawListSharedData; + double Time; + int FrameCount; + int FrameCountEnded; + int FrameCountRendered; + bool WithinFrameScope; // Set by NewFrame(), cleared by EndFrame() + bool WithinFrameScopeWithImplicitWindow; // Set by NewFrame(), cleared by EndFrame() when the implicit debug window has been pushed + bool WithinEndChild; // Set within EndChild() + bool GcCompactAll; // Request full GC + bool TestEngineHookItems; // Will call test engine hooks: ImGuiTestEngineHook_ItemAdd(), ImGuiTestEngineHook_ItemInfo(), ImGuiTestEngineHook_Log() + ImGuiID TestEngineHookIdInfo; // Will call test engine hooks: ImGuiTestEngineHook_IdInfo() from GetID() + void* TestEngine; // Test engine user data + + // Windows state + ImVector Windows; // Windows, sorted in display order, back to front + ImVector WindowsFocusOrder; // Root windows, sorted in focus order, back to front. + ImVector WindowsTempSortBuffer; // Temporary buffer used in EndFrame() to reorder windows so parents are kept before their child + ImVector CurrentWindowStack; + ImGuiStorage WindowsById; // Map window's ImGuiID to ImGuiWindow* + int WindowsActiveCount; // Number of unique windows submitted by frame + ImVec2 WindowsHoverPadding; // Padding around resizable windows for which hovering on counts as hovering the window == ImMax(style.TouchExtraPadding, WINDOWS_HOVER_PADDING) + ImGuiWindow* CurrentWindow; // Window being drawn into + ImGuiWindow* HoveredWindow; // Window the mouse is hovering. Will typically catch mouse inputs. + ImGuiWindow* HoveredWindowUnderMovingWindow; // Hovered window ignoring MovingWindow. Only set if MovingWindow is set. + ImGuiWindow* MovingWindow; // Track the window we clicked on (in order to preserve focus). The actual window that is moved is generally MovingWindow->RootWindow. + ImGuiWindow* WheelingWindow; // Track the window we started mouse-wheeling on. Until a timer elapse or mouse has moved, generally keep scrolling the same window even if during the course of scrolling the mouse ends up hovering a child window. + ImVec2 WheelingWindowRefMousePos; + float WheelingWindowTimer; + + // Item/widgets state and tracking information + ImGuiID HoveredId; // Hovered widget, filled during the frame + ImGuiID HoveredIdPreviousFrame; + bool HoveredIdAllowOverlap; + bool HoveredIdUsingMouseWheel; // Hovered widget will use mouse wheel. Blocks scrolling the underlying window. + bool HoveredIdPreviousFrameUsingMouseWheel; + bool HoveredIdDisabled; // At least one widget passed the rect test, but has been discarded by disabled flag or popup inhibit. May be true even if HoveredId == 0. + float HoveredIdTimer; // Measure contiguous hovering time + float HoveredIdNotActiveTimer; // Measure contiguous hovering time where the item has not been active + ImGuiID ActiveId; // Active widget + ImGuiID ActiveIdIsAlive; // Active widget has been seen this frame (we can't use a bool as the ActiveId may change within the frame) + float ActiveIdTimer; + bool ActiveIdIsJustActivated; // Set at the time of activation for one frame + bool ActiveIdAllowOverlap; // Active widget allows another widget to steal active id (generally for overlapping widgets, but not always) + bool ActiveIdNoClearOnFocusLoss; // Disable losing active id if the active id window gets unfocused. + bool ActiveIdHasBeenPressedBefore; // Track whether the active id led to a press (this is to allow changing between PressOnClick and PressOnRelease without pressing twice). Used by range_select branch. + bool ActiveIdHasBeenEditedBefore; // Was the value associated to the widget Edited over the course of the Active state. + bool ActiveIdHasBeenEditedThisFrame; + bool ActiveIdUsingMouseWheel; // Active widget will want to read mouse wheel. Blocks scrolling the underlying window. + ImU32 ActiveIdUsingNavDirMask; // Active widget will want to read those nav move requests (e.g. can activate a button and move away from it) + ImU32 ActiveIdUsingNavInputMask; // Active widget will want to read those nav inputs. + ImU64 ActiveIdUsingKeyInputMask; // Active widget will want to read those key inputs. When we grow the ImGuiKey enum we'll need to either to order the enum to make useful keys come first, either redesign this into e.g. a small array. + ImVec2 ActiveIdClickOffset; // Clicked offset from upper-left corner, if applicable (currently only set by ButtonBehavior) + ImGuiWindow* ActiveIdWindow; + ImGuiInputSource ActiveIdSource; // Activating with mouse or nav (gamepad/keyboard) + int ActiveIdMouseButton; + ImGuiID ActiveIdPreviousFrame; + bool ActiveIdPreviousFrameIsAlive; + bool ActiveIdPreviousFrameHasBeenEditedBefore; + ImGuiWindow* ActiveIdPreviousFrameWindow; + ImGuiID LastActiveId; // Store the last non-zero ActiveId, useful for animation. + float LastActiveIdTimer; // Store the last non-zero ActiveId timer since the beginning of activation, useful for animation. + + // Next window/item data + ImGuiItemFlags CurrentItemFlags; // == g.ItemFlagsStack.back() + ImGuiNextItemData NextItemData; // Storage for SetNextItem** functions + ImGuiLastItemData LastItemData; // Storage for last submitted item (setup by ItemAdd) + ImGuiNextWindowData NextWindowData; // Storage for SetNextWindow** functions + + // Shared stacks + ImVector ColorStack; // Stack for PushStyleColor()/PopStyleColor() - inherited by Begin() + ImVector StyleVarStack; // Stack for PushStyleVar()/PopStyleVar() - inherited by Begin() + ImVector FontStack; // Stack for PushFont()/PopFont() - inherited by Begin() + ImVector FocusScopeStack; // Stack for PushFocusScope()/PopFocusScope() - not inherited by Begin(), unless child window + ImVectorItemFlagsStack; // Stack for PushItemFlag()/PopItemFlag() - inherited by Begin() + ImVectorGroupStack; // Stack for BeginGroup()/EndGroup() - not inherited by Begin() + ImVectorOpenPopupStack; // Which popups are open (persistent) + ImVectorBeginPopupStack; // Which level of BeginPopup() we are in (reset every frame) + + // Viewports + ImVector Viewports; // Active viewports (Size==1 in 'master' branch). Each viewports hold their copy of ImDrawData. + + // Gamepad/keyboard Navigation + ImGuiWindow* NavWindow; // Focused window for navigation. Could be called 'FocusWindow' + ImGuiID NavId; // Focused item for navigation + ImGuiID NavFocusScopeId; // Identify a selection scope (selection code often wants to "clear other items" when landing on an item of the selection set) + ImGuiID NavActivateId; // ~~ (g.ActiveId == 0) && IsNavInputPressed(ImGuiNavInput_Activate) ? NavId : 0, also set when calling ActivateItem() + ImGuiID NavActivateDownId; // ~~ IsNavInputDown(ImGuiNavInput_Activate) ? NavId : 0 + ImGuiID NavActivatePressedId; // ~~ IsNavInputPressed(ImGuiNavInput_Activate) ? NavId : 0 + ImGuiID NavInputId; // ~~ IsNavInputPressed(ImGuiNavInput_Input) ? NavId : 0 + ImGuiID NavJustTabbedId; // Just tabbed to this id. + ImGuiID NavJustMovedToId; // Just navigated to this id (result of a successfully MoveRequest). + ImGuiID NavJustMovedToFocusScopeId; // Just navigated to this focus scope id (result of a successfully MoveRequest). + ImGuiKeyModFlags NavJustMovedToKeyMods; + ImGuiID NavNextActivateId; // Set by ActivateItem(), queued until next frame. + ImGuiInputSource NavInputSource; // Keyboard or Gamepad mode? THIS WILL ONLY BE None or NavGamepad or NavKeyboard. + ImRect NavScoringRect; // Rectangle used for scoring, in screen space. Based of window->NavRectRel[], modified for directional navigation scoring. + int NavScoringCount; // Metrics for debugging + ImGuiNavLayer NavLayer; // Layer we are navigating on. For now the system is hard-coded for 0=main contents and 1=menu/title bar, may expose layers later. + int NavIdTabCounter; // == NavWindow->DC.FocusIdxTabCounter at time of NavId processing + bool NavIdIsAlive; // Nav widget has been seen this frame ~~ NavRectRel is valid + bool NavMousePosDirty; // When set we will update mouse position if (io.ConfigFlags & ImGuiConfigFlags_NavEnableSetMousePos) if set (NB: this not enabled by default) + bool NavDisableHighlight; // When user starts using mouse, we hide gamepad/keyboard highlight (NB: but they are still available, which is why NavDisableHighlight isn't always != NavDisableMouseHover) + bool NavDisableMouseHover; // When user starts using gamepad/keyboard, we hide mouse hovering highlight until mouse is touched again. + bool NavAnyRequest; // ~~ NavMoveRequest || NavInitRequest + bool NavInitRequest; // Init request for appearing window to select first item + bool NavInitRequestFromMove; + ImGuiID NavInitResultId; // Init request result (first item of the window, or one for which SetItemDefaultFocus() was called) + ImRect NavInitResultRectRel; // Init request result rectangle (relative to parent window) + bool NavMoveRequest; // Move request for this frame + ImGuiNavMoveFlags NavMoveRequestFlags; + ImGuiNavForward NavMoveRequestForward; // None / ForwardQueued / ForwardActive (this is used to navigate sibling parent menus from a child menu) + ImGuiKeyModFlags NavMoveRequestKeyMods; + ImGuiDir NavMoveDir, NavMoveDirLast; // Direction of the move request (left/right/up/down), direction of the previous move request + ImGuiDir NavMoveClipDir; // FIXME-NAV: Describe the purpose of this better. Might want to rename? + ImGuiNavItemData NavMoveResultLocal; // Best move request candidate within NavWindow + ImGuiNavItemData NavMoveResultLocalVisibleSet; // Best move request candidate within NavWindow that are mostly visible (when using ImGuiNavMoveFlags_AlsoScoreVisibleSet flag) + ImGuiNavItemData NavMoveResultOther; // Best move request candidate within NavWindow's flattened hierarchy (when using ImGuiWindowFlags_NavFlattened flag) + ImGuiWindow* NavWrapRequestWindow; // Window which requested trying nav wrap-around. + ImGuiNavMoveFlags NavWrapRequestFlags; // Wrap-around operation flags. + + // Navigation: Windowing (CTRL+TAB for list, or Menu button + keys or directional pads to move/resize) + ImGuiWindow* NavWindowingTarget; // Target window when doing CTRL+Tab (or Pad Menu + FocusPrev/Next), this window is temporarily displayed top-most! + ImGuiWindow* NavWindowingTargetAnim; // Record of last valid NavWindowingTarget until DimBgRatio and NavWindowingHighlightAlpha becomes 0.0f, so the fade-out can stay on it. + ImGuiWindow* NavWindowingListWindow; // Internal window actually listing the CTRL+Tab contents + float NavWindowingTimer; + float NavWindowingHighlightAlpha; + bool NavWindowingToggleLayer; + + // Legacy Focus/Tabbing system (older than Nav, active even if Nav is disabled, misnamed. FIXME-NAV: This needs a redesign!) + ImGuiWindow* TabFocusRequestCurrWindow; // + ImGuiWindow* TabFocusRequestNextWindow; // + int TabFocusRequestCurrCounterRegular; // Any item being requested for focus, stored as an index (we on layout to be stable between the frame pressing TAB and the next frame, semi-ouch) + int TabFocusRequestCurrCounterTabStop; // Tab item being requested for focus, stored as an index + int TabFocusRequestNextCounterRegular; // Stored for next frame + int TabFocusRequestNextCounterTabStop; // " + bool TabFocusPressed; // Set in NewFrame() when user pressed Tab + + // Render + float DimBgRatio; // 0.0..1.0 animation when fading in a dimming background (for modal window and CTRL+TAB list) + ImGuiMouseCursor MouseCursor; + + // Drag and Drop + bool DragDropActive; + bool DragDropWithinSource; // Set when within a BeginDragDropXXX/EndDragDropXXX block for a drag source. + bool DragDropWithinTarget; // Set when within a BeginDragDropXXX/EndDragDropXXX block for a drag target. + ImGuiDragDropFlags DragDropSourceFlags; + int DragDropSourceFrameCount; + int DragDropMouseButton; + ImGuiPayload DragDropPayload; + ImRect DragDropTargetRect; // Store rectangle of current target candidate (we favor small targets when overlapping) + ImGuiID DragDropTargetId; + ImGuiDragDropFlags DragDropAcceptFlags; + float DragDropAcceptIdCurrRectSurface; // Target item surface (we resolve overlapping targets by prioritizing the smaller surface) + ImGuiID DragDropAcceptIdCurr; // Target item id (set at the time of accepting the payload) + ImGuiID DragDropAcceptIdPrev; // Target item id from previous frame (we need to store this to allow for overlapping drag and drop targets) + int DragDropAcceptFrameCount; // Last time a target expressed a desire to accept the source + ImGuiID DragDropHoldJustPressedId; // Set when holding a payload just made ButtonBehavior() return a press. + ImVector DragDropPayloadBufHeap; // We don't expose the ImVector<> directly, ImGuiPayload only holds pointer+size + unsigned char DragDropPayloadBufLocal[16]; // Local buffer for small payloads + + // Table + ImGuiTable* CurrentTable; + int CurrentTableStackIdx; + ImPool Tables; + ImVector TablesTempDataStack; + ImVector TablesLastTimeActive; // Last used timestamp of each tables (SOA, for efficient GC) + ImVector DrawChannelsTempMergeBuffer; + + // Tab bars + ImGuiTabBar* CurrentTabBar; + ImPool TabBars; + ImVector CurrentTabBarStack; + ImVector ShrinkWidthBuffer; + + // Widget state + ImVec2 LastValidMousePos; + ImGuiInputTextState InputTextState; + ImFont InputTextPasswordFont; + ImGuiID TempInputId; // Temporary text input when CTRL+clicking on a slider, etc. + ImGuiColorEditFlags ColorEditOptions; // Store user options for color edit widgets + float ColorEditLastHue; // Backup of last Hue associated to LastColor[3], so we can restore Hue in lossy RGB<>HSV round trips + float ColorEditLastSat; // Backup of last Saturation associated to LastColor[3], so we can restore Saturation in lossy RGB<>HSV round trips + float ColorEditLastColor[3]; + ImVec4 ColorPickerRef; // Initial/reference color at the time of opening the color picker. + ImGuiComboPreviewData ComboPreviewData; + float SliderCurrentAccum; // Accumulated slider delta when using navigation controls. + bool SliderCurrentAccumDirty; // Has the accumulated slider delta changed since last time we tried to apply it? + bool DragCurrentAccumDirty; + float DragCurrentAccum; // Accumulator for dragging modification. Always high-precision, not rounded by end-user precision settings + float DragSpeedDefaultRatio; // If speed == 0.0f, uses (max-min) * DragSpeedDefaultRatio + float DisabledAlphaBackup; // Backup for style.Alpha for BeginDisabled() + float ScrollbarClickDeltaToGrabCenter; // Distance between mouse and center of grab box, normalized in parent space. Use storage? + int TooltipOverrideCount; + float TooltipSlowDelay; // Time before slow tooltips appears (FIXME: This is temporary until we merge in tooltip timer+priority work) + ImVector ClipboardHandlerData; // If no custom clipboard handler is defined + ImVector MenusIdSubmittedThisFrame; // A list of menu IDs that were rendered at least once + + // Platform support + ImVec2 PlatformImePos; // Cursor position request & last passed to the OS Input Method Editor + ImVec2 PlatformImeLastPos; + char PlatformLocaleDecimalPoint; // '.' or *localeconv()->decimal_point + + // Settings + bool SettingsLoaded; + float SettingsDirtyTimer; // Save .ini Settings to memory when time reaches zero + ImGuiTextBuffer SettingsIniData; // In memory .ini settings + ImVector SettingsHandlers; // List of .ini settings handlers + ImChunkStream SettingsWindows; // ImGuiWindow .ini settings entries + ImChunkStream SettingsTables; // ImGuiTable .ini settings entries + ImVector Hooks; // Hooks for extensions (e.g. test engine) + ImGuiID HookIdNext; // Next available HookId + + // Capture/Logging + bool LogEnabled; // Currently capturing + ImGuiLogType LogType; // Capture target + ImFileHandle LogFile; // If != NULL log to stdout/ file + ImGuiTextBuffer LogBuffer; // Accumulation buffer when log to clipboard. This is pointer so our GImGui static constructor doesn't call heap allocators. + const char* LogNextPrefix; + const char* LogNextSuffix; + float LogLinePosY; + bool LogLineFirstItem; + int LogDepthRef; + int LogDepthToExpand; + int LogDepthToExpandDefault; // Default/stored value for LogDepthMaxExpand if not specified in the LogXXX function call. + + // Debug Tools + bool DebugItemPickerActive; // Item picker is active (started with DebugStartItemPicker()) + ImGuiID DebugItemPickerBreakId; // Will call IM_DEBUG_BREAK() when encountering this id + ImGuiMetricsConfig DebugMetricsConfig; + + // Misc + float FramerateSecPerFrame[120]; // Calculate estimate of framerate for user over the last 2 seconds. + int FramerateSecPerFrameIdx; + int FramerateSecPerFrameCount; + float FramerateSecPerFrameAccum; + int WantCaptureMouseNextFrame; // Explicit capture via CaptureKeyboardFromApp()/CaptureMouseFromApp() sets those flags + int WantCaptureKeyboardNextFrame; + int WantTextInputNextFrame; + char TempBuffer[1024 * 3 + 1]; // Temporary text buffer + + ImGuiContext(ImFontAtlas* shared_font_atlas) + { + Initialized = false; + FontAtlasOwnedByContext = shared_font_atlas ? false : true; + Font = NULL; + FontSize = FontBaseSize = 0.0f; + IO.Fonts = shared_font_atlas ? shared_font_atlas : IM_NEW(ImFontAtlas)(); + Time = 0.0f; + FrameCount = 0; + FrameCountEnded = FrameCountRendered = -1; + WithinFrameScope = WithinFrameScopeWithImplicitWindow = WithinEndChild = false; + GcCompactAll = false; + TestEngineHookItems = false; + TestEngineHookIdInfo = 0; + TestEngine = NULL; + + WindowsActiveCount = 0; + CurrentWindow = NULL; + HoveredWindow = NULL; + HoveredWindowUnderMovingWindow = NULL; + MovingWindow = NULL; + WheelingWindow = NULL; + WheelingWindowTimer = 0.0f; + + HoveredId = HoveredIdPreviousFrame = 0; + HoveredIdAllowOverlap = false; + HoveredIdUsingMouseWheel = HoveredIdPreviousFrameUsingMouseWheel = false; + HoveredIdDisabled = false; + HoveredIdTimer = HoveredIdNotActiveTimer = 0.0f; + ActiveId = 0; + ActiveIdIsAlive = 0; + ActiveIdTimer = 0.0f; + ActiveIdIsJustActivated = false; + ActiveIdAllowOverlap = false; + ActiveIdNoClearOnFocusLoss = false; + ActiveIdHasBeenPressedBefore = false; + ActiveIdHasBeenEditedBefore = false; + ActiveIdHasBeenEditedThisFrame = false; + ActiveIdUsingMouseWheel = false; + ActiveIdUsingNavDirMask = 0x00; + ActiveIdUsingNavInputMask = 0x00; + ActiveIdUsingKeyInputMask = 0x00; + ActiveIdClickOffset = ImVec2(-1, -1); + ActiveIdWindow = NULL; + ActiveIdSource = ImGuiInputSource_None; + ActiveIdMouseButton = -1; + ActiveIdPreviousFrame = 0; + ActiveIdPreviousFrameIsAlive = false; + ActiveIdPreviousFrameHasBeenEditedBefore = false; + ActiveIdPreviousFrameWindow = NULL; + LastActiveId = 0; + LastActiveIdTimer = 0.0f; + + CurrentItemFlags = ImGuiItemFlags_None; + + NavWindow = NULL; + NavId = NavFocusScopeId = NavActivateId = NavActivateDownId = NavActivatePressedId = NavInputId = 0; + NavJustTabbedId = NavJustMovedToId = NavJustMovedToFocusScopeId = NavNextActivateId = 0; + NavJustMovedToKeyMods = ImGuiKeyModFlags_None; + NavInputSource = ImGuiInputSource_None; + NavScoringRect = ImRect(); + NavScoringCount = 0; + NavLayer = ImGuiNavLayer_Main; + NavIdTabCounter = INT_MAX; + NavIdIsAlive = false; + NavMousePosDirty = false; + NavDisableHighlight = true; + NavDisableMouseHover = false; + NavAnyRequest = false; + NavInitRequest = false; + NavInitRequestFromMove = false; + NavInitResultId = 0; + NavMoveRequest = false; + NavMoveRequestFlags = ImGuiNavMoveFlags_None; + NavMoveRequestForward = ImGuiNavForward_None; + NavMoveRequestKeyMods = ImGuiKeyModFlags_None; + NavMoveDir = NavMoveDirLast = NavMoveClipDir = ImGuiDir_None; + NavWrapRequestWindow = NULL; + NavWrapRequestFlags = ImGuiNavMoveFlags_None; + + NavWindowingTarget = NavWindowingTargetAnim = NavWindowingListWindow = NULL; + NavWindowingTimer = NavWindowingHighlightAlpha = 0.0f; + NavWindowingToggleLayer = false; + + TabFocusRequestCurrWindow = TabFocusRequestNextWindow = NULL; + TabFocusRequestCurrCounterRegular = TabFocusRequestCurrCounterTabStop = INT_MAX; + TabFocusRequestNextCounterRegular = TabFocusRequestNextCounterTabStop = INT_MAX; + TabFocusPressed = false; + + DimBgRatio = 0.0f; + MouseCursor = ImGuiMouseCursor_Arrow; + + DragDropActive = DragDropWithinSource = DragDropWithinTarget = false; + DragDropSourceFlags = ImGuiDragDropFlags_None; + DragDropSourceFrameCount = -1; + DragDropMouseButton = -1; + DragDropTargetId = 0; + DragDropAcceptFlags = ImGuiDragDropFlags_None; + DragDropAcceptIdCurrRectSurface = 0.0f; + DragDropAcceptIdPrev = DragDropAcceptIdCurr = 0; + DragDropAcceptFrameCount = -1; + DragDropHoldJustPressedId = 0; + memset(DragDropPayloadBufLocal, 0, sizeof(DragDropPayloadBufLocal)); + + CurrentTable = NULL; + CurrentTableStackIdx = -1; + CurrentTabBar = NULL; + + LastValidMousePos = ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f); + TempInputId = 0; + ColorEditOptions = ImGuiColorEditFlags_DefaultOptions_; + ColorEditLastHue = ColorEditLastSat = 0.0f; + ColorEditLastColor[0] = ColorEditLastColor[1] = ColorEditLastColor[2] = FLT_MAX; + SliderCurrentAccum = 0.0f; + SliderCurrentAccumDirty = false; + DragCurrentAccumDirty = false; + DragCurrentAccum = 0.0f; + DragSpeedDefaultRatio = 1.0f / 100.0f; + DisabledAlphaBackup = 0.0f; + ScrollbarClickDeltaToGrabCenter = 0.0f; + TooltipOverrideCount = 0; + TooltipSlowDelay = 0.50f; + + PlatformImePos = PlatformImeLastPos = ImVec2(FLT_MAX, FLT_MAX); + PlatformLocaleDecimalPoint = '.'; + + SettingsLoaded = false; + SettingsDirtyTimer = 0.0f; + HookIdNext = 0; + + LogEnabled = false; + LogType = ImGuiLogType_None; + LogNextPrefix = LogNextSuffix = NULL; + LogFile = NULL; + LogLinePosY = FLT_MAX; + LogLineFirstItem = false; + LogDepthRef = 0; + LogDepthToExpand = LogDepthToExpandDefault = 2; + + DebugItemPickerActive = false; + DebugItemPickerBreakId = 0; + + memset(FramerateSecPerFrame, 0, sizeof(FramerateSecPerFrame)); + FramerateSecPerFrameIdx = FramerateSecPerFrameCount = 0; + FramerateSecPerFrameAccum = 0.0f; + WantCaptureMouseNextFrame = WantCaptureKeyboardNextFrame = WantTextInputNextFrame = -1; + memset(TempBuffer, 0, sizeof(TempBuffer)); + } +}; + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] ImGuiWindowTempData, ImGuiWindow +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// Transient per-window data, reset at the beginning of the frame. This used to be called ImGuiDrawContext, hence the DC variable name in ImGuiWindow. +// (That's theory, in practice the delimitation between ImGuiWindow and ImGuiWindowTempData is quite tenuous and could be reconsidered..) +// (This doesn't need a constructor because we zero-clear it as part of ImGuiWindow and all frame-temporary data are setup on Begin) +struct IMGUI_API ImGuiWindowTempData +{ + // Layout + ImVec2 CursorPos; // Current emitting position, in absolute coordinates. + ImVec2 CursorPosPrevLine; + ImVec2 CursorStartPos; // Initial position after Begin(), generally ~ window position + WindowPadding. + ImVec2 CursorMaxPos; // Used to implicitly calculate ContentSize at the beginning of next frame, for scrolling range and auto-resize. Always growing during the frame. + ImVec2 IdealMaxPos; // Used to implicitly calculate ContentSizeIdeal at the beginning of next frame, for auto-resize only. Always growing during the frame. + ImVec2 CurrLineSize; + ImVec2 PrevLineSize; + float CurrLineTextBaseOffset; // Baseline offset (0.0f by default on a new line, generally == style.FramePadding.y when a framed item has been added). + float PrevLineTextBaseOffset; + ImVec1 Indent; // Indentation / start position from left of window (increased by TreePush/TreePop, etc.) + ImVec1 ColumnsOffset; // Offset to the current column (if ColumnsCurrent > 0). FIXME: This and the above should be a stack to allow use cases like Tree->Column->Tree. Need revamp columns API. + ImVec1 GroupOffset; + + // Keyboard/Gamepad navigation + ImGuiNavLayer NavLayerCurrent; // Current layer, 0..31 (we currently only use 0..1) + short NavLayersActiveMask; // Which layers have been written to (result from previous frame) + short NavLayersActiveMaskNext;// Which layers have been written to (accumulator for current frame) + ImGuiID NavFocusScopeIdCurrent; // Current focus scope ID while appending + bool NavHideHighlightOneFrame; + bool NavHasScroll; // Set when scrolling can be used (ScrollMax > 0.0f) + + // Miscellaneous + bool MenuBarAppending; // FIXME: Remove this + ImVec2 MenuBarOffset; // MenuBarOffset.x is sort of equivalent of a per-layer CursorPos.x, saved/restored as we switch to the menu bar. The only situation when MenuBarOffset.y is > 0 if when (SafeAreaPadding.y > FramePadding.y), often used on TVs. + ImGuiMenuColumns MenuColumns; // Simplified columns storage for menu items measurement + int TreeDepth; // Current tree depth. + ImU32 TreeJumpToParentOnPopMask; // Store a copy of !g.NavIdIsAlive for TreeDepth 0..31.. Could be turned into a ImU64 if necessary. + ImVector ChildWindows; + ImGuiStorage* StateStorage; // Current persistent per-window storage (store e.g. tree node open/close state) + ImGuiOldColumns* CurrentColumns; // Current columns set + int CurrentTableIdx; // Current table index (into g.Tables) + ImGuiLayoutType LayoutType; + ImGuiLayoutType ParentLayoutType; // Layout type of parent window at the time of Begin() + int FocusCounterRegular; // (Legacy Focus/Tabbing system) Sequential counter, start at -1 and increase as assigned via FocusableItemRegister() (FIXME-NAV: Needs redesign) + int FocusCounterTabStop; // (Legacy Focus/Tabbing system) Same, but only count widgets which you can Tab through. + + // Local parameters stacks + // We store the current settings outside of the vectors to increase memory locality (reduce cache misses). The vectors are rarely modified. Also it allows us to not heap allocate for short-lived windows which are not using those settings. + float ItemWidth; // Current item width (>0.0: width in pixels, <0.0: align xx pixels to the right of window). + float TextWrapPos; // Current text wrap pos. + ImVector ItemWidthStack; // Store item widths to restore (attention: .back() is not == ItemWidth) + ImVector TextWrapPosStack; // Store text wrap pos to restore (attention: .back() is not == TextWrapPos) + ImGuiStackSizes StackSizesOnBegin; // Store size of various stacks for asserting +}; + +// Storage for one window +struct IMGUI_API ImGuiWindow +{ + char* Name; // Window name, owned by the window. + ImGuiID ID; // == ImHashStr(Name) + ImGuiWindowFlags Flags; // See enum ImGuiWindowFlags_ + ImVec2 Pos; // Position (always rounded-up to nearest pixel) + ImVec2 Size; // Current size (==SizeFull or collapsed title bar size) + ImVec2 SizeFull; // Size when non collapsed + ImVec2 ContentSize; // Size of contents/scrollable client area (calculated from the extents reach of the cursor) from previous frame. Does not include window decoration or window padding. + ImVec2 ContentSizeIdeal; + ImVec2 ContentSizeExplicit; // Size of contents/scrollable client area explicitly request by the user via SetNextWindowContentSize(). + ImVec2 WindowPadding; // Window padding at the time of Begin(). + float WindowRounding; // Window rounding at the time of Begin(). May be clamped lower to avoid rendering artifacts with title bar, menu bar etc. + float WindowBorderSize; // Window border size at the time of Begin(). + int NameBufLen; // Size of buffer storing Name. May be larger than strlen(Name)! + ImGuiID MoveId; // == window->GetID("#MOVE") + ImGuiID ChildId; // ID of corresponding item in parent window (for navigation to return from child window to parent window) + ImVec2 Scroll; + ImVec2 ScrollMax; + ImVec2 ScrollTarget; // target scroll position. stored as cursor position with scrolling canceled out, so the highest point is always 0.0f. (FLT_MAX for no change) + ImVec2 ScrollTargetCenterRatio; // 0.0f = scroll so that target position is at top, 0.5f = scroll so that target position is centered + ImVec2 ScrollTargetEdgeSnapDist; // 0.0f = no snapping, >0.0f snapping threshold + ImVec2 ScrollbarSizes; // Size taken by each scrollbars on their smaller axis. Pay attention! ScrollbarSizes.x == width of the vertical scrollbar, ScrollbarSizes.y = height of the horizontal scrollbar. + bool ScrollbarX, ScrollbarY; // Are scrollbars visible? + bool Active; // Set to true on Begin(), unless Collapsed + bool WasActive; + bool WriteAccessed; // Set to true when any widget access the current window + bool Collapsed; // Set when collapsing window to become only title-bar + bool WantCollapseToggle; + bool SkipItems; // Set when items can safely be all clipped (e.g. window not visible or collapsed) + bool Appearing; // Set during the frame where the window is appearing (or re-appearing) + bool Hidden; // Do not display (== HiddenFrames*** > 0) + bool IsFallbackWindow; // Set on the "Debug##Default" window. + bool HasCloseButton; // Set when the window has a close button (p_open != NULL) + signed char ResizeBorderHeld; // Current border being held for resize (-1: none, otherwise 0-3) + short BeginCount; // Number of Begin() during the current frame (generally 0 or 1, 1+ if appending via multiple Begin/End pairs) + short BeginOrderWithinParent; // Begin() order within immediate parent window, if we are a child window. Otherwise 0. + short BeginOrderWithinContext; // Begin() order within entire imgui context. This is mostly used for debugging submission order related issues. + short FocusOrder; // Order within WindowsFocusOrder[], altered when windows are focused. + ImGuiID PopupId; // ID in the popup stack when this window is used as a popup/menu (because we use generic Name/ID for recycling) + ImS8 AutoFitFramesX, AutoFitFramesY; + ImS8 AutoFitChildAxises; + bool AutoFitOnlyGrows; + ImGuiDir AutoPosLastDirection; + ImS8 HiddenFramesCanSkipItems; // Hide the window for N frames + ImS8 HiddenFramesCannotSkipItems; // Hide the window for N frames while allowing items to be submitted so we can measure their size + ImS8 HiddenFramesForRenderOnly; // Hide the window until frame N at Render() time only + ImS8 DisableInputsFrames; // Disable window interactions for N frames + ImGuiCond SetWindowPosAllowFlags : 8; // store acceptable condition flags for SetNextWindowPos() use. + ImGuiCond SetWindowSizeAllowFlags : 8; // store acceptable condition flags for SetNextWindowSize() use. + ImGuiCond SetWindowCollapsedAllowFlags : 8; // store acceptable condition flags for SetNextWindowCollapsed() use. + ImVec2 SetWindowPosVal; // store window position when using a non-zero Pivot (position set needs to be processed when we know the window size) + ImVec2 SetWindowPosPivot; // store window pivot for positioning. ImVec2(0, 0) when positioning from top-left corner; ImVec2(0.5f, 0.5f) for centering; ImVec2(1, 1) for bottom right. + + ImVector IDStack; // ID stack. ID are hashes seeded with the value at the top of the stack. (In theory this should be in the TempData structure) + ImGuiWindowTempData DC; // Temporary per-window data, reset at the beginning of the frame. This used to be called ImGuiDrawContext, hence the "DC" variable name. + + // The best way to understand what those rectangles are is to use the 'Metrics->Tools->Show Windows Rectangles' viewer. + // The main 'OuterRect', omitted as a field, is window->Rect(). + ImRect OuterRectClipped; // == Window->Rect() just after setup in Begin(). == window->Rect() for root window. + ImRect InnerRect; // Inner rectangle (omit title bar, menu bar, scroll bar) + ImRect InnerClipRect; // == InnerRect shrunk by WindowPadding*0.5f on each side, clipped within viewport or parent clip rect. + ImRect WorkRect; // Initially covers the whole scrolling region. Reduced by containers e.g columns/tables when active. Shrunk by WindowPadding*1.0f on each side. This is meant to replace ContentRegionRect over time (from 1.71+ onward). + ImRect ParentWorkRect; // Backup of WorkRect before entering a container such as columns/tables. Used by e.g. SpanAllColumns functions to easily access. Stacked containers are responsible for maintaining this. // FIXME-WORKRECT: Could be a stack? + ImRect ClipRect; // Current clipping/scissoring rectangle, evolve as we are using PushClipRect(), etc. == DrawList->clip_rect_stack.back(). + ImRect ContentRegionRect; // FIXME: This is currently confusing/misleading. It is essentially WorkRect but not handling of scrolling. We currently rely on it as right/bottom aligned sizing operation need some size to rely on. + ImVec2ih HitTestHoleSize; // Define an optional rectangular hole where mouse will pass-through the window. + ImVec2ih HitTestHoleOffset; + + int LastFrameActive; // Last frame number the window was Active. + float LastTimeActive; // Last timestamp the window was Active (using float as we don't need high precision there) + float ItemWidthDefault; + ImGuiStorage StateStorage; + ImVector ColumnsStorage; + float FontWindowScale; // User scale multiplier per-window, via SetWindowFontScale() + int SettingsOffset; // Offset into SettingsWindows[] (offsets are always valid as we only grow the array from the back) + + ImDrawList* DrawList; // == &DrawListInst (for backward compatibility reason with code using imgui_internal.h we keep this a pointer) + ImDrawList DrawListInst; + ImGuiWindow* ParentWindow; // If we are a child _or_ popup window, this is pointing to our parent. Otherwise NULL. + ImGuiWindow* RootWindow; // Point to ourself or first ancestor that is not a child window == Top-level window. + ImGuiWindow* RootWindowForTitleBarHighlight; // Point to ourself or first ancestor which will display TitleBgActive color when this window is active. + ImGuiWindow* RootWindowForNav; // Point to ourself or first ancestor which doesn't have the NavFlattened flag. + + ImGuiWindow* NavLastChildNavWindow; // When going to the menu bar, we remember the child window we came from. (This could probably be made implicit if we kept g.Windows sorted by last focused including child window.) + ImGuiID NavLastIds[ImGuiNavLayer_COUNT]; // Last known NavId for this window, per layer (0/1) + ImRect NavRectRel[ImGuiNavLayer_COUNT]; // Reference rectangle, in window relative space + + int MemoryDrawListIdxCapacity; // Backup of last idx/vtx count, so when waking up the window we can preallocate and avoid iterative alloc/copy + int MemoryDrawListVtxCapacity; + bool MemoryCompacted; // Set when window extraneous data have been garbage collected + +public: + ImGuiWindow(ImGuiContext* context, const char* name); + ~ImGuiWindow(); + + ImGuiID GetID(const char* str, const char* str_end = NULL); + ImGuiID GetID(const void* ptr); + ImGuiID GetID(int n); + ImGuiID GetIDNoKeepAlive(const char* str, const char* str_end = NULL); + ImGuiID GetIDNoKeepAlive(const void* ptr); + ImGuiID GetIDNoKeepAlive(int n); + ImGuiID GetIDFromRectangle(const ImRect& r_abs); + + // We don't use g.FontSize because the window may be != g.CurrentWidow. + ImRect Rect() const { return ImRect(Pos.x, Pos.y, Pos.x + Size.x, Pos.y + Size.y); } + float CalcFontSize() const { ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; float scale = g.FontBaseSize * FontWindowScale; if (ParentWindow) scale *= ParentWindow->FontWindowScale; return scale; } + float TitleBarHeight() const { ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; return (Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar) ? 0.0f : CalcFontSize() + g.Style.FramePadding.y * 2.0f; } + ImRect TitleBarRect() const { return ImRect(Pos, ImVec2(Pos.x + SizeFull.x, Pos.y + TitleBarHeight())); } + float MenuBarHeight() const { ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; return (Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_MenuBar) ? DC.MenuBarOffset.y + CalcFontSize() + g.Style.FramePadding.y * 2.0f : 0.0f; } + ImRect MenuBarRect() const { float y1 = Pos.y + TitleBarHeight(); return ImRect(Pos.x, y1, Pos.x + SizeFull.x, y1 + MenuBarHeight()); } +}; + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Tab bar, Tab item support +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// Extend ImGuiTabBarFlags_ +enum ImGuiTabBarFlagsPrivate_ +{ + ImGuiTabBarFlags_DockNode = 1 << 20, // Part of a dock node [we don't use this in the master branch but it facilitate branch syncing to keep this around] + ImGuiTabBarFlags_IsFocused = 1 << 21, + ImGuiTabBarFlags_SaveSettings = 1 << 22 // FIXME: Settings are handled by the docking system, this only request the tab bar to mark settings dirty when reordering tabs +}; + +// Extend ImGuiTabItemFlags_ +enum ImGuiTabItemFlagsPrivate_ +{ + ImGuiTabItemFlags_SectionMask_ = ImGuiTabItemFlags_Leading | ImGuiTabItemFlags_Trailing, + ImGuiTabItemFlags_NoCloseButton = 1 << 20, // Track whether p_open was set or not (we'll need this info on the next frame to recompute ContentWidth during layout) + ImGuiTabItemFlags_Button = 1 << 21 // Used by TabItemButton, change the tab item behavior to mimic a button +}; + +// Storage for one active tab item (sizeof() 40 bytes) +struct ImGuiTabItem +{ + ImGuiID ID; + ImGuiTabItemFlags Flags; + int LastFrameVisible; + int LastFrameSelected; // This allows us to infer an ordered list of the last activated tabs with little maintenance + float Offset; // Position relative to beginning of tab + float Width; // Width currently displayed + float ContentWidth; // Width of label, stored during BeginTabItem() call + ImS32 NameOffset; // When Window==NULL, offset to name within parent ImGuiTabBar::TabsNames + ImS16 BeginOrder; // BeginTabItem() order, used to re-order tabs after toggling ImGuiTabBarFlags_Reorderable + ImS16 IndexDuringLayout; // Index only used during TabBarLayout() + bool WantClose; // Marked as closed by SetTabItemClosed() + + ImGuiTabItem() { memset(this, 0, sizeof(*this)); LastFrameVisible = LastFrameSelected = -1; NameOffset = -1; BeginOrder = IndexDuringLayout = -1; } +}; + +// Storage for a tab bar (sizeof() 152 bytes) +struct ImGuiTabBar +{ + ImVector Tabs; + ImGuiTabBarFlags Flags; + ImGuiID ID; // Zero for tab-bars used by docking + ImGuiID SelectedTabId; // Selected tab/window + ImGuiID NextSelectedTabId; // Next selected tab/window. Will also trigger a scrolling animation + ImGuiID VisibleTabId; // Can occasionally be != SelectedTabId (e.g. when previewing contents for CTRL+TAB preview) + int CurrFrameVisible; + int PrevFrameVisible; + ImRect BarRect; + float CurrTabsContentsHeight; + float PrevTabsContentsHeight; // Record the height of contents submitted below the tab bar + float WidthAllTabs; // Actual width of all tabs (locked during layout) + float WidthAllTabsIdeal; // Ideal width if all tabs were visible and not clipped + float ScrollingAnim; + float ScrollingTarget; + float ScrollingTargetDistToVisibility; + float ScrollingSpeed; + float ScrollingRectMinX; + float ScrollingRectMaxX; + ImGuiID ReorderRequestTabId; + ImS16 ReorderRequestOffset; + ImS8 BeginCount; + bool WantLayout; + bool VisibleTabWasSubmitted; + bool TabsAddedNew; // Set to true when a new tab item or button has been added to the tab bar during last frame + ImS16 TabsActiveCount; // Number of tabs submitted this frame. + ImS16 LastTabItemIdx; // Index of last BeginTabItem() tab for use by EndTabItem() + float ItemSpacingY; + ImVec2 FramePadding; // style.FramePadding locked at the time of BeginTabBar() + ImVec2 BackupCursorPos; + ImGuiTextBuffer TabsNames; // For non-docking tab bar we re-append names in a contiguous buffer. + + ImGuiTabBar(); + int GetTabOrder(const ImGuiTabItem* tab) const { return Tabs.index_from_ptr(tab); } + const char* GetTabName(const ImGuiTabItem* tab) const + { + IM_ASSERT(tab->NameOffset != -1 && tab->NameOffset < TabsNames.Buf.Size); + return TabsNames.Buf.Data + tab->NameOffset; + } +}; + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Table support +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +#define IM_COL32_DISABLE IM_COL32(0,0,0,1) // Special sentinel code which cannot be used as a regular color. +#define IMGUI_TABLE_MAX_COLUMNS 64 // sizeof(ImU64) * 8. This is solely because we frequently encode columns set in a ImU64. +#define IMGUI_TABLE_MAX_DRAW_CHANNELS (4 + 64 * 2) // See TableSetupDrawChannels() + +// Our current column maximum is 64 but we may raise that in the future. +typedef ImS8 ImGuiTableColumnIdx; +typedef ImU8 ImGuiTableDrawChannelIdx; + +// [Internal] sizeof() ~ 104 +// We use the terminology "Enabled" to refer to a column that is not Hidden by user/api. +// We use the terminology "Clipped" to refer to a column that is out of sight because of scrolling/clipping. +// This is in contrast with some user-facing api such as IsItemVisible() / IsRectVisible() which use "Visible" to mean "not clipped". +struct ImGuiTableColumn +{ + ImGuiTableColumnFlags Flags; // Flags after some patching (not directly same as provided by user). See ImGuiTableColumnFlags_ + float WidthGiven; // Final/actual width visible == (MaxX - MinX), locked in TableUpdateLayout(). May be > WidthRequest to honor minimum width, may be < WidthRequest to honor shrinking columns down in tight space. + float MinX; // Absolute positions + float MaxX; + float WidthRequest; // Master width absolute value when !(Flags & _WidthStretch). When Stretch this is derived every frame from StretchWeight in TableUpdateLayout() + float WidthAuto; // Automatic width + float StretchWeight; // Master width weight when (Flags & _WidthStretch). Often around ~1.0f initially. + float InitStretchWeightOrWidth; // Value passed to TableSetupColumn(). For Width it is a content width (_without padding_). + ImRect ClipRect; // Clipping rectangle for the column + ImGuiID UserID; // Optional, value passed to TableSetupColumn() + float WorkMinX; // Contents region min ~(MinX + CellPaddingX + CellSpacingX1) == cursor start position when entering column + float WorkMaxX; // Contents region max ~(MaxX - CellPaddingX - CellSpacingX2) + float ItemWidth; // Current item width for the column, preserved across rows + float ContentMaxXFrozen; // Contents maximum position for frozen rows (apart from headers), from which we can infer content width. + float ContentMaxXUnfrozen; + float ContentMaxXHeadersUsed; // Contents maximum position for headers rows (regardless of freezing). TableHeader() automatically softclip itself + report ideal desired size, to avoid creating extraneous draw calls + float ContentMaxXHeadersIdeal; + ImS16 NameOffset; // Offset into parent ColumnsNames[] + ImGuiTableColumnIdx DisplayOrder; // Index within Table's IndexToDisplayOrder[] (column may be reordered by users) + ImGuiTableColumnIdx IndexWithinEnabledSet; // Index within enabled/visible set (<= IndexToDisplayOrder) + ImGuiTableColumnIdx PrevEnabledColumn; // Index of prev enabled/visible column within Columns[], -1 if first enabled/visible column + ImGuiTableColumnIdx NextEnabledColumn; // Index of next enabled/visible column within Columns[], -1 if last enabled/visible column + ImGuiTableColumnIdx SortOrder; // Index of this column within sort specs, -1 if not sorting on this column, 0 for single-sort, may be >0 on multi-sort + ImGuiTableDrawChannelIdx DrawChannelCurrent; // Index within DrawSplitter.Channels[] + ImGuiTableDrawChannelIdx DrawChannelFrozen; // Draw channels for frozen rows (often headers) + ImGuiTableDrawChannelIdx DrawChannelUnfrozen; // Draw channels for unfrozen rows + bool IsEnabled; // IsUserEnabled && (Flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_Disabled) == 0 + bool IsUserEnabled; // Is the column not marked Hidden by the user? (unrelated to being off view, e.g. clipped by scrolling). + bool IsUserEnabledNextFrame; + bool IsVisibleX; // Is actually in view (e.g. overlapping the host window clipping rectangle, not scrolled). + bool IsVisibleY; + bool IsRequestOutput; // Return value for TableSetColumnIndex() / TableNextColumn(): whether we request user to output contents or not. + bool IsSkipItems; // Do we want item submissions to this column to be completely ignored (no layout will happen). + bool IsPreserveWidthAuto; + ImS8 NavLayerCurrent; // ImGuiNavLayer in 1 byte + ImU8 AutoFitQueue; // Queue of 8 values for the next 8 frames to request auto-fit + ImU8 CannotSkipItemsQueue; // Queue of 8 values for the next 8 frames to disable Clipped/SkipItem + ImU8 SortDirection : 2; // ImGuiSortDirection_Ascending or ImGuiSortDirection_Descending + ImU8 SortDirectionsAvailCount : 2; // Number of available sort directions (0 to 3) + ImU8 SortDirectionsAvailMask : 4; // Mask of available sort directions (1-bit each) + ImU8 SortDirectionsAvailList; // Ordered of available sort directions (2-bits each) + + ImGuiTableColumn() + { + memset(this, 0, sizeof(*this)); + StretchWeight = WidthRequest = -1.0f; + NameOffset = -1; + DisplayOrder = IndexWithinEnabledSet = -1; + PrevEnabledColumn = NextEnabledColumn = -1; + SortOrder = -1; + SortDirection = ImGuiSortDirection_None; + DrawChannelCurrent = DrawChannelFrozen = DrawChannelUnfrozen = (ImU8)-1; + } +}; + +// Transient cell data stored per row. +// sizeof() ~ 6 +struct ImGuiTableCellData +{ + ImU32 BgColor; // Actual color + ImGuiTableColumnIdx Column; // Column number +}; + +// FIXME-TABLE: more transient data could be stored in a per-stacked table structure: DrawSplitter, SortSpecs, incoming RowData +struct ImGuiTable +{ + ImGuiID ID; + ImGuiTableFlags Flags; + void* RawData; // Single allocation to hold Columns[], DisplayOrderToIndex[] and RowCellData[] + ImGuiTableTempData* TempData; // Transient data while table is active. Point within g.CurrentTableStack[] + ImSpan Columns; // Point within RawData[] + ImSpan DisplayOrderToIndex; // Point within RawData[]. Store display order of columns (when not reordered, the values are 0...Count-1) + ImSpan RowCellData; // Point within RawData[]. Store cells background requests for current row. + ImU64 EnabledMaskByDisplayOrder; // Column DisplayOrder -> IsEnabled map + ImU64 EnabledMaskByIndex; // Column Index -> IsEnabled map (== not hidden by user/api) in a format adequate for iterating column without touching cold data + ImU64 VisibleMaskByIndex; // Column Index -> IsVisibleX|IsVisibleY map (== not hidden by user/api && not hidden by scrolling/cliprect) + ImU64 RequestOutputMaskByIndex; // Column Index -> IsVisible || AutoFit (== expect user to submit items) + ImGuiTableFlags SettingsLoadedFlags; // Which data were loaded from the .ini file (e.g. when order is not altered we won't save order) + int SettingsOffset; // Offset in g.SettingsTables + int LastFrameActive; + int ColumnsCount; // Number of columns declared in BeginTable() + int CurrentRow; + int CurrentColumn; + ImS16 InstanceCurrent; // Count of BeginTable() calls with same ID in the same frame (generally 0). This is a little bit similar to BeginCount for a window, but multiple table with same ID look are multiple tables, they are just synched. + ImS16 InstanceInteracted; // Mark which instance (generally 0) of the same ID is being interacted with + float RowPosY1; + float RowPosY2; + float RowMinHeight; // Height submitted to TableNextRow() + float RowTextBaseline; + float RowIndentOffsetX; + ImGuiTableRowFlags RowFlags : 16; // Current row flags, see ImGuiTableRowFlags_ + ImGuiTableRowFlags LastRowFlags : 16; + int RowBgColorCounter; // Counter for alternating background colors (can be fast-forwarded by e.g clipper), not same as CurrentRow because header rows typically don't increase this. + ImU32 RowBgColor[2]; // Background color override for current row. + ImU32 BorderColorStrong; + ImU32 BorderColorLight; + float BorderX1; + float BorderX2; + float HostIndentX; + float MinColumnWidth; + float OuterPaddingX; + float CellPaddingX; // Padding from each borders + float CellPaddingY; + float CellSpacingX1; // Spacing between non-bordered cells + float CellSpacingX2; + float LastOuterHeight; // Outer height from last frame + float LastFirstRowHeight; // Height of first row from last frame + float InnerWidth; // User value passed to BeginTable(), see comments at the top of BeginTable() for details. + float ColumnsGivenWidth; // Sum of current column width + float ColumnsAutoFitWidth; // Sum of ideal column width in order nothing to be clipped, used for auto-fitting and content width submission in outer window + float ResizedColumnNextWidth; + float ResizeLockMinContentsX2; // Lock minimum contents width while resizing down in order to not create feedback loops. But we allow growing the table. + float RefScale; // Reference scale to be able to rescale columns on font/dpi changes. + ImRect OuterRect; // Note: for non-scrolling table, OuterRect.Max.y is often FLT_MAX until EndTable(), unless a height has been specified in BeginTable(). + ImRect InnerRect; // InnerRect but without decoration. As with OuterRect, for non-scrolling tables, InnerRect.Max.y is + ImRect WorkRect; + ImRect InnerClipRect; + ImRect BgClipRect; // We use this to cpu-clip cell background color fill + ImRect Bg0ClipRectForDrawCmd; // Actual ImDrawCmd clip rect for BG0/1 channel. This tends to be == OuterWindow->ClipRect at BeginTable() because output in BG0/BG1 is cpu-clipped + ImRect Bg2ClipRectForDrawCmd; // Actual ImDrawCmd clip rect for BG2 channel. This tends to be a correct, tight-fit, because output to BG2 are done by widgets relying on regular ClipRect. + ImRect HostClipRect; // This is used to check if we can eventually merge our columns draw calls into the current draw call of the current window. + ImRect HostBackupInnerClipRect; // Backup of InnerWindow->ClipRect during PushTableBackground()/PopTableBackground() + ImGuiWindow* OuterWindow; // Parent window for the table + ImGuiWindow* InnerWindow; // Window holding the table data (== OuterWindow or a child window) + ImGuiTextBuffer ColumnsNames; // Contiguous buffer holding columns names + ImDrawListSplitter* DrawSplitter; // Shortcut to TempData->DrawSplitter while in table. Isolate draw commands per columns to avoid switching clip rect constantly + ImGuiTableColumnSortSpecs SortSpecsSingle; + ImVector SortSpecsMulti; // FIXME-OPT: Using a small-vector pattern would be good. + ImGuiTableSortSpecs SortSpecs; // Public facing sorts specs, this is what we return in TableGetSortSpecs() + ImGuiTableColumnIdx SortSpecsCount; + ImGuiTableColumnIdx ColumnsEnabledCount; // Number of enabled columns (<= ColumnsCount) + ImGuiTableColumnIdx ColumnsEnabledFixedCount; // Number of enabled columns (<= ColumnsCount) + ImGuiTableColumnIdx DeclColumnsCount; // Count calls to TableSetupColumn() + ImGuiTableColumnIdx HoveredColumnBody; // Index of column whose visible region is being hovered. Important: == ColumnsCount when hovering empty region after the right-most column! + ImGuiTableColumnIdx HoveredColumnBorder; // Index of column whose right-border is being hovered (for resizing). + ImGuiTableColumnIdx AutoFitSingleColumn; // Index of single column requesting auto-fit. + ImGuiTableColumnIdx ResizedColumn; // Index of column being resized. Reset when InstanceCurrent==0. + ImGuiTableColumnIdx LastResizedColumn; // Index of column being resized from previous frame. + ImGuiTableColumnIdx HeldHeaderColumn; // Index of column header being held. + ImGuiTableColumnIdx ReorderColumn; // Index of column being reordered. (not cleared) + ImGuiTableColumnIdx ReorderColumnDir; // -1 or +1 + ImGuiTableColumnIdx LeftMostEnabledColumn; // Index of left-most non-hidden column. + ImGuiTableColumnIdx RightMostEnabledColumn; // Index of right-most non-hidden column. + ImGuiTableColumnIdx LeftMostStretchedColumn; // Index of left-most stretched column. + ImGuiTableColumnIdx RightMostStretchedColumn; // Index of right-most stretched column. + ImGuiTableColumnIdx ContextPopupColumn; // Column right-clicked on, of -1 if opening context menu from a neutral/empty spot + ImGuiTableColumnIdx FreezeRowsRequest; // Requested frozen rows count + ImGuiTableColumnIdx FreezeRowsCount; // Actual frozen row count (== FreezeRowsRequest, or == 0 when no scrolling offset) + ImGuiTableColumnIdx FreezeColumnsRequest; // Requested frozen columns count + ImGuiTableColumnIdx FreezeColumnsCount; // Actual frozen columns count (== FreezeColumnsRequest, or == 0 when no scrolling offset) + ImGuiTableColumnIdx RowCellDataCurrent; // Index of current RowCellData[] entry in current row + ImGuiTableDrawChannelIdx DummyDrawChannel; // Redirect non-visible columns here. + ImGuiTableDrawChannelIdx Bg2DrawChannelCurrent; // For Selectable() and other widgets drawing across columns after the freezing line. Index within DrawSplitter.Channels[] + ImGuiTableDrawChannelIdx Bg2DrawChannelUnfrozen; + bool IsLayoutLocked; // Set by TableUpdateLayout() which is called when beginning the first row. + bool IsInsideRow; // Set when inside TableBeginRow()/TableEndRow(). + bool IsInitializing; + bool IsSortSpecsDirty; + bool IsUsingHeaders; // Set when the first row had the ImGuiTableRowFlags_Headers flag. + bool IsContextPopupOpen; // Set when default context menu is open (also see: ContextPopupColumn, InstanceInteracted). + bool IsSettingsRequestLoad; + bool IsSettingsDirty; // Set when table settings have changed and needs to be reported into ImGuiTableSetttings data. + bool IsDefaultDisplayOrder; // Set when display order is unchanged from default (DisplayOrder contains 0...Count-1) + bool IsResetAllRequest; + bool IsResetDisplayOrderRequest; + bool IsUnfrozenRows; // Set when we got past the frozen row. + bool IsDefaultSizingPolicy; // Set if user didn't explicitly set a sizing policy in BeginTable() + bool MemoryCompacted; + bool HostSkipItems; // Backup of InnerWindow->SkipItem at the end of BeginTable(), because we will overwrite InnerWindow->SkipItem on a per-column basis + + IMGUI_API ImGuiTable() { memset(this, 0, sizeof(*this)); LastFrameActive = -1; } + IMGUI_API ~ImGuiTable() { IM_FREE(RawData); } +}; + +// Transient data that are only needed between BeginTable() and EndTable(), those buffers are shared (1 per level of stacked table). +// - Accessing those requires chasing an extra pointer so for very frequently used data we leave them in the main table structure. +// - We also leave out of this structure data that tend to be particularly useful for debugging/metrics. +struct ImGuiTableTempData +{ + int TableIndex; // Index in g.Tables.Buf[] pool + float LastTimeActive; // Last timestamp this structure was used + + ImVec2 UserOuterSize; // outer_size.x passed to BeginTable() + ImDrawListSplitter DrawSplitter; + + ImRect HostBackupWorkRect; // Backup of InnerWindow->WorkRect at the end of BeginTable() + ImRect HostBackupParentWorkRect; // Backup of InnerWindow->ParentWorkRect at the end of BeginTable() + ImVec2 HostBackupPrevLineSize; // Backup of InnerWindow->DC.PrevLineSize at the end of BeginTable() + ImVec2 HostBackupCurrLineSize; // Backup of InnerWindow->DC.CurrLineSize at the end of BeginTable() + ImVec2 HostBackupCursorMaxPos; // Backup of InnerWindow->DC.CursorMaxPos at the end of BeginTable() + ImVec1 HostBackupColumnsOffset; // Backup of OuterWindow->DC.ColumnsOffset at the end of BeginTable() + float HostBackupItemWidth; // Backup of OuterWindow->DC.ItemWidth at the end of BeginTable() + int HostBackupItemWidthStackSize;//Backup of OuterWindow->DC.ItemWidthStack.Size at the end of BeginTable() + + IMGUI_API ImGuiTableTempData() { memset(this, 0, sizeof(*this)); LastTimeActive = -1.0f; } +}; + +// sizeof() ~ 12 +struct ImGuiTableColumnSettings +{ + float WidthOrWeight; + ImGuiID UserID; + ImGuiTableColumnIdx Index; + ImGuiTableColumnIdx DisplayOrder; + ImGuiTableColumnIdx SortOrder; + ImU8 SortDirection : 2; + ImU8 IsEnabled : 1; // "Visible" in ini file + ImU8 IsStretch : 1; + + ImGuiTableColumnSettings() + { + WidthOrWeight = 0.0f; + UserID = 0; + Index = -1; + DisplayOrder = SortOrder = -1; + SortDirection = ImGuiSortDirection_None; + IsEnabled = 1; + IsStretch = 0; + } +}; + +// This is designed to be stored in a single ImChunkStream (1 header followed by N ImGuiTableColumnSettings, etc.) +struct ImGuiTableSettings +{ + ImGuiID ID; // Set to 0 to invalidate/delete the setting + ImGuiTableFlags SaveFlags; // Indicate data we want to save using the Resizable/Reorderable/Sortable/Hideable flags (could be using its own flags..) + float RefScale; // Reference scale to be able to rescale columns on font/dpi changes. + ImGuiTableColumnIdx ColumnsCount; + ImGuiTableColumnIdx ColumnsCountMax; // Maximum number of columns this settings instance can store, we can recycle a settings instance with lower number of columns but not higher + bool WantApply; // Set when loaded from .ini data (to enable merging/loading .ini data into an already running context) + + ImGuiTableSettings() { memset(this, 0, sizeof(*this)); } + ImGuiTableColumnSettings* GetColumnSettings() { return (ImGuiTableColumnSettings*)(this + 1); } +}; + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] ImGui internal API +// No guarantee of forward compatibility here! +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +namespace ImGui +{ + // Windows + // We should always have a CurrentWindow in the stack (there is an implicit "Debug" window) + // If this ever crash because g.CurrentWindow is NULL it means that either + // - ImGui::NewFrame() has never been called, which is illegal. + // - You are calling ImGui functions after ImGui::EndFrame()/ImGui::Render() and before the next ImGui::NewFrame(), which is also illegal. + inline ImGuiWindow* GetCurrentWindowRead() { ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; return g.CurrentWindow; } + inline ImGuiWindow* GetCurrentWindow() { ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; g.CurrentWindow->WriteAccessed = true; return g.CurrentWindow; } + IMGUI_API ImGuiWindow* FindWindowByID(ImGuiID id); + IMGUI_API ImGuiWindow* FindWindowByName(const char* name); + IMGUI_API void UpdateWindowParentAndRootLinks(ImGuiWindow* window, ImGuiWindowFlags flags, ImGuiWindow* parent_window); + IMGUI_API ImVec2 CalcWindowNextAutoFitSize(ImGuiWindow* window); + IMGUI_API bool IsWindowChildOf(ImGuiWindow* window, ImGuiWindow* potential_parent); + IMGUI_API bool IsWindowAbove(ImGuiWindow* potential_above, ImGuiWindow* potential_below); + IMGUI_API bool IsWindowNavFocusable(ImGuiWindow* window); + IMGUI_API void SetWindowPos(ImGuiWindow* window, const ImVec2& pos, ImGuiCond cond = 0); + IMGUI_API void SetWindowSize(ImGuiWindow* window, const ImVec2& size, ImGuiCond cond = 0); + IMGUI_API void SetWindowCollapsed(ImGuiWindow* window, bool collapsed, ImGuiCond cond = 0); + IMGUI_API void SetWindowHitTestHole(ImGuiWindow* window, const ImVec2& pos, const ImVec2& size); + + // Windows: Display Order and Focus Order + IMGUI_API void FocusWindow(ImGuiWindow* window); + IMGUI_API void FocusTopMostWindowUnderOne(ImGuiWindow* under_this_window, ImGuiWindow* ignore_window); + IMGUI_API void BringWindowToFocusFront(ImGuiWindow* window); + IMGUI_API void BringWindowToDisplayFront(ImGuiWindow* window); + IMGUI_API void BringWindowToDisplayBack(ImGuiWindow* window); + + // Fonts, drawing + IMGUI_API void SetCurrentFont(ImFont* font); + inline ImFont* GetDefaultFont() { ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; return g.IO.FontDefault ? g.IO.FontDefault : g.IO.Fonts->Fonts[0]; } + inline ImDrawList* GetForegroundDrawList(ImGuiWindow* window) { IM_UNUSED(window); return GetForegroundDrawList(); } // This seemingly unnecessary wrapper simplifies compatibility between the 'master' and 'docking' branches. + IMGUI_API ImDrawList* GetBackgroundDrawList(ImGuiViewport* viewport); // get background draw list for the given viewport. this draw list will be the first rendering one. Useful to quickly draw shapes/text behind dear imgui contents. + IMGUI_API ImDrawList* GetForegroundDrawList(ImGuiViewport* viewport); // get foreground draw list for the given viewport. this draw list will be the last rendered one. Useful to quickly draw shapes/text over dear imgui contents. + + // Init + IMGUI_API void Initialize(ImGuiContext* context); + IMGUI_API void Shutdown(ImGuiContext* context); // Since 1.60 this is a _private_ function. You can call DestroyContext() to destroy the context created by CreateContext(). + + // NewFrame + IMGUI_API void UpdateHoveredWindowAndCaptureFlags(); + IMGUI_API void StartMouseMovingWindow(ImGuiWindow* window); + IMGUI_API void UpdateMouseMovingWindowNewFrame(); + IMGUI_API void UpdateMouseMovingWindowEndFrame(); + + // Generic context hooks + IMGUI_API ImGuiID AddContextHook(ImGuiContext* context, const ImGuiContextHook* hook); + IMGUI_API void RemoveContextHook(ImGuiContext* context, ImGuiID hook_to_remove); + IMGUI_API void CallContextHooks(ImGuiContext* context, ImGuiContextHookType type); + + // Settings + IMGUI_API void MarkIniSettingsDirty(); + IMGUI_API void MarkIniSettingsDirty(ImGuiWindow* window); + IMGUI_API void ClearIniSettings(); + IMGUI_API ImGuiWindowSettings* CreateNewWindowSettings(const char* name); + IMGUI_API ImGuiWindowSettings* FindWindowSettings(ImGuiID id); + IMGUI_API ImGuiWindowSettings* FindOrCreateWindowSettings(const char* name); + IMGUI_API ImGuiSettingsHandler* FindSettingsHandler(const char* type_name); + + // Scrolling + IMGUI_API void SetNextWindowScroll(const ImVec2& scroll); // Use -1.0f on one axis to leave as-is + IMGUI_API void SetScrollX(ImGuiWindow* window, float scroll_x); + IMGUI_API void SetScrollY(ImGuiWindow* window, float scroll_y); + IMGUI_API void SetScrollFromPosX(ImGuiWindow* window, float local_x, float center_x_ratio); + IMGUI_API void SetScrollFromPosY(ImGuiWindow* window, float local_y, float center_y_ratio); + IMGUI_API ImVec2 ScrollToBringRectIntoView(ImGuiWindow* window, const ImRect& item_rect); + + // Basic Accessors + inline ImGuiID GetItemID() { ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; return g.LastItemData.ID; } // Get ID of last item (~~ often same ImGui::GetID(label) beforehand) + inline ImGuiItemStatusFlags GetItemStatusFlags(){ ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; return g.LastItemData.StatusFlags; } + inline ImGuiItemFlags GetItemFlags() { ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; return g.LastItemData.InFlags; } + inline ImGuiID GetActiveID() { ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; return g.ActiveId; } + inline ImGuiID GetFocusID() { ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; return g.NavId; } + IMGUI_API void SetActiveID(ImGuiID id, ImGuiWindow* window); + IMGUI_API void SetFocusID(ImGuiID id, ImGuiWindow* window); + IMGUI_API void ClearActiveID(); + IMGUI_API ImGuiID GetHoveredID(); + IMGUI_API void SetHoveredID(ImGuiID id); + IMGUI_API void KeepAliveID(ImGuiID id); + IMGUI_API void MarkItemEdited(ImGuiID id); // Mark data associated to given item as "edited", used by IsItemDeactivatedAfterEdit() function. + IMGUI_API void PushOverrideID(ImGuiID id); // Push given value as-is at the top of the ID stack (whereas PushID combines old and new hashes) + IMGUI_API ImGuiID GetIDWithSeed(const char* str_id_begin, const char* str_id_end, ImGuiID seed); + + // Basic Helpers for widget code + IMGUI_API void ItemSize(const ImVec2& size, float text_baseline_y = -1.0f); + IMGUI_API void ItemSize(const ImRect& bb, float text_baseline_y = -1.0f); + IMGUI_API bool ItemAdd(const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id, const ImRect* nav_bb = NULL, ImGuiItemAddFlags flags = 0); + IMGUI_API bool ItemHoverable(const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id); + IMGUI_API void ItemFocusable(ImGuiWindow* window, ImGuiID id); + IMGUI_API bool IsClippedEx(const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id, bool clip_even_when_logged); + IMGUI_API ImVec2 CalcItemSize(ImVec2 size, float default_w, float default_h); + IMGUI_API float CalcWrapWidthForPos(const ImVec2& pos, float wrap_pos_x); + IMGUI_API void PushMultiItemsWidths(int components, float width_full); + IMGUI_API bool IsItemToggledSelection(); // Was the last item selection toggled? (after Selectable(), TreeNode() etc. We only returns toggle _event_ in order to handle clipping correctly) + IMGUI_API ImVec2 GetContentRegionMaxAbs(); + IMGUI_API void ShrinkWidths(ImGuiShrinkWidthItem* items, int count, float width_excess); + + // Parameter stacks + IMGUI_API void PushItemFlag(ImGuiItemFlags option, bool enabled); + IMGUI_API void PopItemFlag(); + +#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_OBSOLETE_FUNCTIONS + // If you have old/custom copy-and-pasted widgets that used FocusableItemRegister(): + // (Old) IMGUI_VERSION_NUM < 18209: using 'ItemAdd(....)' and 'bool focused = FocusableItemRegister(...)' + // (New) IMGUI_VERSION_NUM >= 18209: using 'ItemAdd(..., ImGuiItemAddFlags_Focusable)' and 'bool focused = (GetItemStatusFlags() & ImGuiItemStatusFlags_Focused) != 0' + // Widget code are simplified as there's no need to call FocusableItemUnregister() while managing the transition from regular widget to TempInputText() + inline bool FocusableItemRegister(ImGuiWindow* window, ImGuiID id) { IM_ASSERT(0); IM_UNUSED(window); IM_UNUSED(id); return false; } // -> pass ImGuiItemAddFlags_Focusable flag to ItemAdd() + inline IM_NORETURN void FocusableItemUnregister(ImGuiWindow* window) { IM_ASSERT(0); IM_UNUSED(window); } // -> unnecessary: TempInputText() uses ImGuiInputTextFlags_MergedItem +#endif + + // Logging/Capture + IMGUI_API void LogBegin(ImGuiLogType type, int auto_open_depth); // -> BeginCapture() when we design v2 api, for now stay under the radar by using the old name. + IMGUI_API void LogToBuffer(int auto_open_depth = -1); // Start logging/capturing to internal buffer + IMGUI_API void LogRenderedText(const ImVec2* ref_pos, const char* text, const char* text_end = NULL); + IMGUI_API void LogSetNextTextDecoration(const char* prefix, const char* suffix); + + // Popups, Modals, Tooltips + IMGUI_API bool BeginChildEx(const char* name, ImGuiID id, const ImVec2& size_arg, bool border, ImGuiWindowFlags flags); + IMGUI_API void OpenPopupEx(ImGuiID id, ImGuiPopupFlags popup_flags = ImGuiPopupFlags_None); + IMGUI_API void ClosePopupToLevel(int remaining, bool restore_focus_to_window_under_popup); + IMGUI_API void ClosePopupsOverWindow(ImGuiWindow* ref_window, bool restore_focus_to_window_under_popup); + IMGUI_API bool IsPopupOpen(ImGuiID id, ImGuiPopupFlags popup_flags); + IMGUI_API bool BeginPopupEx(ImGuiID id, ImGuiWindowFlags extra_flags); + IMGUI_API void BeginTooltipEx(ImGuiWindowFlags extra_flags, ImGuiTooltipFlags tooltip_flags); + IMGUI_API ImRect GetPopupAllowedExtentRect(ImGuiWindow* window); + IMGUI_API ImGuiWindow* GetTopMostPopupModal(); + IMGUI_API ImVec2 FindBestWindowPosForPopup(ImGuiWindow* window); + IMGUI_API ImVec2 FindBestWindowPosForPopupEx(const ImVec2& ref_pos, const ImVec2& size, ImGuiDir* last_dir, const ImRect& r_outer, const ImRect& r_avoid, ImGuiPopupPositionPolicy policy); + IMGUI_API bool BeginViewportSideBar(const char* name, ImGuiViewport* viewport, ImGuiDir dir, float size, ImGuiWindowFlags window_flags); + + // Menus + IMGUI_API bool MenuItemEx(const char* label, const char* icon, const char* shortcut = NULL, bool selected = false, bool enabled = true); + + // Combos + IMGUI_API bool BeginComboPopup(ImGuiID popup_id, const ImRect& bb, ImGuiComboFlags flags); + IMGUI_API bool BeginComboPreview(); + IMGUI_API void EndComboPreview(); + + // Gamepad/Keyboard Navigation + IMGUI_API void NavInitWindow(ImGuiWindow* window, bool force_reinit); + IMGUI_API bool NavMoveRequestButNoResultYet(); + IMGUI_API void NavMoveRequestCancel(); + IMGUI_API void NavMoveRequestForward(ImGuiDir move_dir, ImGuiDir clip_dir, const ImRect& bb_rel, ImGuiNavMoveFlags move_flags); + IMGUI_API void NavMoveRequestTryWrapping(ImGuiWindow* window, ImGuiNavMoveFlags move_flags); + IMGUI_API float GetNavInputAmount(ImGuiNavInput n, ImGuiInputReadMode mode); + IMGUI_API ImVec2 GetNavInputAmount2d(ImGuiNavDirSourceFlags dir_sources, ImGuiInputReadMode mode, float slow_factor = 0.0f, float fast_factor = 0.0f); + IMGUI_API int CalcTypematicRepeatAmount(float t0, float t1, float repeat_delay, float repeat_rate); + IMGUI_API void ActivateItem(ImGuiID id); // Remotely activate a button, checkbox, tree node etc. given its unique ID. activation is queued and processed on the next frame when the item is encountered again. + IMGUI_API void SetNavID(ImGuiID id, ImGuiNavLayer nav_layer, ImGuiID focus_scope_id, const ImRect& rect_rel); + + // Focus Scope (WIP) + // This is generally used to identify a selection set (multiple of which may be in the same window), as selection + // patterns generally need to react (e.g. clear selection) when landing on an item of the set. + IMGUI_API void PushFocusScope(ImGuiID id); + IMGUI_API void PopFocusScope(); + inline ImGuiID GetFocusedFocusScope() { ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; return g.NavFocusScopeId; } // Focus scope which is actually active + inline ImGuiID GetFocusScope() { ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; return g.CurrentWindow->DC.NavFocusScopeIdCurrent; } // Focus scope we are outputting into, set by PushFocusScope() + + // Inputs + // FIXME: Eventually we should aim to move e.g. IsActiveIdUsingKey() into IsKeyXXX functions. + IMGUI_API void SetItemUsingMouseWheel(); + IMGUI_API void SetActiveIdUsingNavAndKeys(); + inline bool IsActiveIdUsingNavDir(ImGuiDir dir) { ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; return (g.ActiveIdUsingNavDirMask & (1 << dir)) != 0; } + inline bool IsActiveIdUsingNavInput(ImGuiNavInput input) { ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; return (g.ActiveIdUsingNavInputMask & (1 << input)) != 0; } + inline bool IsActiveIdUsingKey(ImGuiKey key) { ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; IM_ASSERT(key < 64); return (g.ActiveIdUsingKeyInputMask & ((ImU64)1 << key)) != 0; } + IMGUI_API bool IsMouseDragPastThreshold(ImGuiMouseButton button, float lock_threshold = -1.0f); + inline bool IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey key, bool repeat = true) { ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; const int key_index = g.IO.KeyMap[key]; return (key_index >= 0) ? IsKeyPressed(key_index, repeat) : false; } + inline bool IsNavInputDown(ImGuiNavInput n) { ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; return g.IO.NavInputs[n] > 0.0f; } + inline bool IsNavInputTest(ImGuiNavInput n, ImGuiInputReadMode rm) { return (GetNavInputAmount(n, rm) > 0.0f); } + IMGUI_API ImGuiKeyModFlags GetMergedKeyModFlags(); + + // Drag and Drop + IMGUI_API bool BeginDragDropTargetCustom(const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id); + IMGUI_API void ClearDragDrop(); + IMGUI_API bool IsDragDropPayloadBeingAccepted(); + + // Internal Columns API (this is not exposed because we will encourage transitioning to the Tables API) + IMGUI_API void SetWindowClipRectBeforeSetChannel(ImGuiWindow* window, const ImRect& clip_rect); + IMGUI_API void BeginColumns(const char* str_id, int count, ImGuiOldColumnFlags flags = 0); // setup number of columns. use an identifier to distinguish multiple column sets. close with EndColumns(). + IMGUI_API void EndColumns(); // close columns + IMGUI_API void PushColumnClipRect(int column_index); + IMGUI_API void PushColumnsBackground(); + IMGUI_API void PopColumnsBackground(); + IMGUI_API ImGuiID GetColumnsID(const char* str_id, int count); + IMGUI_API ImGuiOldColumns* FindOrCreateColumns(ImGuiWindow* window, ImGuiID id); + IMGUI_API float GetColumnOffsetFromNorm(const ImGuiOldColumns* columns, float offset_norm); + IMGUI_API float GetColumnNormFromOffset(const ImGuiOldColumns* columns, float offset); + + // Tables: Candidates for public API + IMGUI_API void TableOpenContextMenu(int column_n = -1); + IMGUI_API void TableSetColumnWidth(int column_n, float width); + IMGUI_API void TableSetColumnSortDirection(int column_n, ImGuiSortDirection sort_direction, bool append_to_sort_specs); + IMGUI_API int TableGetHoveredColumn(); // May use (TableGetColumnFlags() & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_IsHovered) instead. Return hovered column. return -1 when table is not hovered. return columns_count if the unused space at the right of visible columns is hovered. + IMGUI_API float TableGetHeaderRowHeight(); + IMGUI_API void TablePushBackgroundChannel(); + IMGUI_API void TablePopBackgroundChannel(); + + // Tables: Internals + inline ImGuiTable* GetCurrentTable() { ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; return g.CurrentTable; } + IMGUI_API ImGuiTable* TableFindByID(ImGuiID id); + IMGUI_API bool BeginTableEx(const char* name, ImGuiID id, int columns_count, ImGuiTableFlags flags = 0, const ImVec2& outer_size = ImVec2(0, 0), float inner_width = 0.0f); + IMGUI_API void TableBeginInitMemory(ImGuiTable* table, int columns_count); + IMGUI_API void TableBeginApplyRequests(ImGuiTable* table); + IMGUI_API void TableSetupDrawChannels(ImGuiTable* table); + IMGUI_API void TableUpdateLayout(ImGuiTable* table); + IMGUI_API void TableUpdateBorders(ImGuiTable* table); + IMGUI_API void TableUpdateColumnsWeightFromWidth(ImGuiTable* table); + IMGUI_API void TableDrawBorders(ImGuiTable* table); + IMGUI_API void TableDrawContextMenu(ImGuiTable* table); + IMGUI_API void TableMergeDrawChannels(ImGuiTable* table); + IMGUI_API void TableSortSpecsSanitize(ImGuiTable* table); + IMGUI_API void TableSortSpecsBuild(ImGuiTable* table); + IMGUI_API ImGuiSortDirection TableGetColumnNextSortDirection(ImGuiTableColumn* column); + IMGUI_API void TableFixColumnSortDirection(ImGuiTable* table, ImGuiTableColumn* column); + IMGUI_API float TableGetColumnWidthAuto(ImGuiTable* table, ImGuiTableColumn* column); + IMGUI_API void TableBeginRow(ImGuiTable* table); + IMGUI_API void TableEndRow(ImGuiTable* table); + IMGUI_API void TableBeginCell(ImGuiTable* table, int column_n); + IMGUI_API void TableEndCell(ImGuiTable* table); + IMGUI_API ImRect TableGetCellBgRect(const ImGuiTable* table, int column_n); + IMGUI_API const char* TableGetColumnName(const ImGuiTable* table, int column_n); + IMGUI_API ImGuiID TableGetColumnResizeID(const ImGuiTable* table, int column_n, int instance_no = 0); + IMGUI_API float TableGetMaxColumnWidth(const ImGuiTable* table, int column_n); + IMGUI_API void TableSetColumnWidthAutoSingle(ImGuiTable* table, int column_n); + IMGUI_API void TableSetColumnWidthAutoAll(ImGuiTable* table); + IMGUI_API void TableRemove(ImGuiTable* table); + IMGUI_API void TableGcCompactTransientBuffers(ImGuiTable* table); + IMGUI_API void TableGcCompactTransientBuffers(ImGuiTableTempData* table); + IMGUI_API void TableGcCompactSettings(); + + // Tables: Settings + IMGUI_API void TableLoadSettings(ImGuiTable* table); + IMGUI_API void TableSaveSettings(ImGuiTable* table); + IMGUI_API void TableResetSettings(ImGuiTable* table); + IMGUI_API ImGuiTableSettings* TableGetBoundSettings(ImGuiTable* table); + IMGUI_API void TableSettingsInstallHandler(ImGuiContext* context); + IMGUI_API ImGuiTableSettings* TableSettingsCreate(ImGuiID id, int columns_count); + IMGUI_API ImGuiTableSettings* TableSettingsFindByID(ImGuiID id); + + // Tab Bars + IMGUI_API bool BeginTabBarEx(ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar, const ImRect& bb, ImGuiTabBarFlags flags); + IMGUI_API ImGuiTabItem* TabBarFindTabByID(ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar, ImGuiID tab_id); + IMGUI_API void TabBarRemoveTab(ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar, ImGuiID tab_id); + IMGUI_API void TabBarCloseTab(ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar, ImGuiTabItem* tab); + IMGUI_API void TabBarQueueReorder(ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar, const ImGuiTabItem* tab, int offset); + IMGUI_API void TabBarQueueReorderFromMousePos(ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar, const ImGuiTabItem* tab, ImVec2 mouse_pos); + IMGUI_API bool TabBarProcessReorder(ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar); + IMGUI_API bool TabItemEx(ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar, const char* label, bool* p_open, ImGuiTabItemFlags flags); + IMGUI_API ImVec2 TabItemCalcSize(const char* label, bool has_close_button); + IMGUI_API void TabItemBackground(ImDrawList* draw_list, const ImRect& bb, ImGuiTabItemFlags flags, ImU32 col); + IMGUI_API void TabItemLabelAndCloseButton(ImDrawList* draw_list, const ImRect& bb, ImGuiTabItemFlags flags, ImVec2 frame_padding, const char* label, ImGuiID tab_id, ImGuiID close_button_id, bool is_contents_visible, bool* out_just_closed, bool* out_text_clipped); + + // Render helpers + // AVOID USING OUTSIDE OF IMGUI.CPP! NOT FOR PUBLIC CONSUMPTION. THOSE FUNCTIONS ARE A MESS. THEIR SIGNATURE AND BEHAVIOR WILL CHANGE, THEY NEED TO BE REFACTORED INTO SOMETHING DECENT. + // NB: All position are in absolute pixels coordinates (we are never using window coordinates internally) + IMGUI_API void RenderText(ImVec2 pos, const char* text, const char* text_end = NULL, bool hide_text_after_hash = true); + IMGUI_API void RenderTextWrapped(ImVec2 pos, const char* text, const char* text_end, float wrap_width); + IMGUI_API void RenderTextClipped(const ImVec2& pos_min, const ImVec2& pos_max, const char* text, const char* text_end, const ImVec2* text_size_if_known, const ImVec2& align = ImVec2(0, 0), const ImRect* clip_rect = NULL); + IMGUI_API void RenderTextClippedEx(ImDrawList* draw_list, const ImVec2& pos_min, const ImVec2& pos_max, const char* text, const char* text_end, const ImVec2* text_size_if_known, const ImVec2& align = ImVec2(0, 0), const ImRect* clip_rect = NULL); + IMGUI_API void RenderTextEllipsis(ImDrawList* draw_list, const ImVec2& pos_min, const ImVec2& pos_max, float clip_max_x, float ellipsis_max_x, const char* text, const char* text_end, const ImVec2* text_size_if_known); + IMGUI_API void RenderFrame(ImVec2 p_min, ImVec2 p_max, ImU32 fill_col, bool border = true, float rounding = 0.0f); + IMGUI_API void RenderFrameBorder(ImVec2 p_min, ImVec2 p_max, float rounding = 0.0f); + IMGUI_API void RenderColorRectWithAlphaCheckerboard(ImDrawList* draw_list, ImVec2 p_min, ImVec2 p_max, ImU32 fill_col, float grid_step, ImVec2 grid_off, float rounding = 0.0f, ImDrawFlags flags = 0); + IMGUI_API void RenderNavHighlight(const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id, ImGuiNavHighlightFlags flags = ImGuiNavHighlightFlags_TypeDefault); // Navigation highlight + IMGUI_API const char* FindRenderedTextEnd(const char* text, const char* text_end = NULL); // Find the optional ## from which we stop displaying text. + + // Render helpers (those functions don't access any ImGui state!) + IMGUI_API void RenderArrow(ImDrawList* draw_list, ImVec2 pos, ImU32 col, ImGuiDir dir, float scale = 1.0f); + IMGUI_API void RenderBullet(ImDrawList* draw_list, ImVec2 pos, ImU32 col); + IMGUI_API void RenderCheckMark(ImDrawList* draw_list, ImVec2 pos, ImU32 col, float sz); + IMGUI_API void RenderMouseCursor(ImDrawList* draw_list, ImVec2 pos, float scale, ImGuiMouseCursor mouse_cursor, ImU32 col_fill, ImU32 col_border, ImU32 col_shadow); + IMGUI_API void RenderArrowPointingAt(ImDrawList* draw_list, ImVec2 pos, ImVec2 half_sz, ImGuiDir direction, ImU32 col); + IMGUI_API void RenderRectFilledRangeH(ImDrawList* draw_list, const ImRect& rect, ImU32 col, float x_start_norm, float x_end_norm, float rounding); + IMGUI_API void RenderRectFilledWithHole(ImDrawList* draw_list, ImRect outer, ImRect inner, ImU32 col, float rounding); + +#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_OBSOLETE_FUNCTIONS + // [1.71: 2019/06/07: Updating prototypes of some of the internal functions. Leaving those for reference for a short while] + inline void RenderArrow(ImVec2 pos, ImGuiDir dir, float scale=1.0f) { ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); RenderArrow(window->DrawList, pos, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text), dir, scale); } + inline void RenderBullet(ImVec2 pos) { ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); RenderBullet(window->DrawList, pos, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text)); } +#endif + + // Widgets + IMGUI_API void TextEx(const char* text, const char* text_end = NULL, ImGuiTextFlags flags = 0); + IMGUI_API bool ButtonEx(const char* label, const ImVec2& size_arg = ImVec2(0, 0), ImGuiButtonFlags flags = 0); + IMGUI_API bool CloseButton(ImGuiID id, const ImVec2& pos); + IMGUI_API bool CollapseButton(ImGuiID id, const ImVec2& pos); + IMGUI_API bool ArrowButtonEx(const char* str_id, ImGuiDir dir, ImVec2 size_arg, ImGuiButtonFlags flags = 0); + IMGUI_API void Scrollbar(ImGuiAxis axis); + IMGUI_API bool ScrollbarEx(const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id, ImGuiAxis axis, float* p_scroll_v, float avail_v, float contents_v, ImDrawFlags flags); + IMGUI_API bool ImageButtonEx(ImGuiID id, ImTextureID texture_id, const ImVec2& size, const ImVec2& uv0, const ImVec2& uv1, const ImVec2& padding, const ImVec4& bg_col, const ImVec4& tint_col); + IMGUI_API ImRect GetWindowScrollbarRect(ImGuiWindow* window, ImGuiAxis axis); + IMGUI_API ImGuiID GetWindowScrollbarID(ImGuiWindow* window, ImGuiAxis axis); + IMGUI_API ImGuiID GetWindowResizeCornerID(ImGuiWindow* window, int n); // 0..3: corners + IMGUI_API ImGuiID GetWindowResizeBorderID(ImGuiWindow* window, ImGuiDir dir); + IMGUI_API void SeparatorEx(ImGuiSeparatorFlags flags); + IMGUI_API bool CheckboxFlags(const char* label, ImS64* flags, ImS64 flags_value); + IMGUI_API bool CheckboxFlags(const char* label, ImU64* flags, ImU64 flags_value); + + // Widgets low-level behaviors + IMGUI_API bool ButtonBehavior(const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id, bool* out_hovered, bool* out_held, ImGuiButtonFlags flags = 0); + IMGUI_API bool DragBehavior(ImGuiID id, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* p_v, float v_speed, const void* p_min, const void* p_max, const char* format, ImGuiSliderFlags flags); + IMGUI_API bool SliderBehavior(const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* p_v, const void* p_min, const void* p_max, const char* format, ImGuiSliderFlags flags, ImRect* out_grab_bb); + IMGUI_API bool SplitterBehavior(const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id, ImGuiAxis axis, float* size1, float* size2, float min_size1, float min_size2, float hover_extend = 0.0f, float hover_visibility_delay = 0.0f); + IMGUI_API bool TreeNodeBehavior(ImGuiID id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags, const char* label, const char* label_end = NULL); + IMGUI_API bool TreeNodeBehaviorIsOpen(ImGuiID id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags = 0); // Consume previous SetNextItemOpen() data, if any. May return true when logging + IMGUI_API void TreePushOverrideID(ImGuiID id); + + // Template functions are instantiated in imgui_widgets.cpp for a finite number of types. + // To use them externally (for custom widget) you may need an "extern template" statement in your code in order to link to existing instances and silence Clang warnings (see #2036). + // e.g. " extern template IMGUI_API float RoundScalarWithFormatT(const char* format, ImGuiDataType data_type, float v); " + template IMGUI_API float ScaleRatioFromValueT(ImGuiDataType data_type, T v, T v_min, T v_max, bool is_logarithmic, float logarithmic_zero_epsilon, float zero_deadzone_size); + template IMGUI_API T ScaleValueFromRatioT(ImGuiDataType data_type, float t, T v_min, T v_max, bool is_logarithmic, float logarithmic_zero_epsilon, float zero_deadzone_size); + template IMGUI_API bool DragBehaviorT(ImGuiDataType data_type, T* v, float v_speed, T v_min, T v_max, const char* format, ImGuiSliderFlags flags); + template IMGUI_API bool SliderBehaviorT(const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id, ImGuiDataType data_type, T* v, T v_min, T v_max, const char* format, ImGuiSliderFlags flags, ImRect* out_grab_bb); + template IMGUI_API T RoundScalarWithFormatT(const char* format, ImGuiDataType data_type, T v); + template IMGUI_API bool CheckboxFlagsT(const char* label, T* flags, T flags_value); + + // Data type helpers + IMGUI_API const ImGuiDataTypeInfo* DataTypeGetInfo(ImGuiDataType data_type); + IMGUI_API int DataTypeFormatString(char* buf, int buf_size, ImGuiDataType data_type, const void* p_data, const char* format); + IMGUI_API void DataTypeApplyOp(ImGuiDataType data_type, int op, void* output, const void* arg_1, const void* arg_2); + IMGUI_API bool DataTypeApplyOpFromText(const char* buf, const char* initial_value_buf, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* p_data, const char* format); + IMGUI_API int DataTypeCompare(ImGuiDataType data_type, const void* arg_1, const void* arg_2); + IMGUI_API bool DataTypeClamp(ImGuiDataType data_type, void* p_data, const void* p_min, const void* p_max); + + // InputText + IMGUI_API bool InputTextEx(const char* label, const char* hint, char* buf, int buf_size, const ImVec2& size_arg, ImGuiInputTextFlags flags, ImGuiInputTextCallback callback = NULL, void* user_data = NULL); + IMGUI_API bool TempInputText(const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id, const char* label, char* buf, int buf_size, ImGuiInputTextFlags flags); + IMGUI_API bool TempInputScalar(const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id, const char* label, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* p_data, const char* format, const void* p_clamp_min = NULL, const void* p_clamp_max = NULL); + inline bool TempInputIsActive(ImGuiID id) { ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; return (g.ActiveId == id && g.TempInputId == id); } + inline ImGuiInputTextState* GetInputTextState(ImGuiID id) { ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; return (g.InputTextState.ID == id) ? &g.InputTextState : NULL; } // Get input text state if active + + // Color + IMGUI_API void ColorTooltip(const char* text, const float* col, ImGuiColorEditFlags flags); + IMGUI_API void ColorEditOptionsPopup(const float* col, ImGuiColorEditFlags flags); + IMGUI_API void ColorPickerOptionsPopup(const float* ref_col, ImGuiColorEditFlags flags); + + // Plot + IMGUI_API int PlotEx(ImGuiPlotType plot_type, const char* label, float (*values_getter)(void* data, int idx), void* data, int values_count, int values_offset, const char* overlay_text, float scale_min, float scale_max, ImVec2 frame_size); + + // Shade functions (write over already created vertices) + IMGUI_API void ShadeVertsLinearColorGradientKeepAlpha(ImDrawList* draw_list, int vert_start_idx, int vert_end_idx, ImVec2 gradient_p0, ImVec2 gradient_p1, ImU32 col0, ImU32 col1); + IMGUI_API void ShadeVertsLinearUV(ImDrawList* draw_list, int vert_start_idx, int vert_end_idx, const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& b, const ImVec2& uv_a, const ImVec2& uv_b, bool clamp); + + // Garbage collection + IMGUI_API void GcCompactTransientMiscBuffers(); + IMGUI_API void GcCompactTransientWindowBuffers(ImGuiWindow* window); + IMGUI_API void GcAwakeTransientWindowBuffers(ImGuiWindow* window); + + // Debug Tools + IMGUI_API void ErrorCheckEndFrameRecover(ImGuiErrorLogCallback log_callback, void* user_data = NULL); + inline void DebugDrawItemRect(ImU32 col = IM_COL32(255,0,0,255)) { ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; GetForegroundDrawList(window)->AddRect(g.LastItemData.Rect.Min, g.LastItemData.Rect.Max, col); } + inline void DebugStartItemPicker() { ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; g.DebugItemPickerActive = true; } + + IMGUI_API void ShowFontAtlas(ImFontAtlas* atlas); + IMGUI_API void DebugNodeColumns(ImGuiOldColumns* columns); + IMGUI_API void DebugNodeDrawList(ImGuiWindow* window, const ImDrawList* draw_list, const char* label); + IMGUI_API void DebugNodeDrawCmdShowMeshAndBoundingBox(ImDrawList* out_draw_list, const ImDrawList* draw_list, const ImDrawCmd* draw_cmd, bool show_mesh, bool show_aabb); + IMGUI_API void DebugNodeFont(ImFont* font); + IMGUI_API void DebugNodeStorage(ImGuiStorage* storage, const char* label); + IMGUI_API void DebugNodeTabBar(ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar, const char* label); + IMGUI_API void DebugNodeTable(ImGuiTable* table); + IMGUI_API void DebugNodeTableSettings(ImGuiTableSettings* settings); + IMGUI_API void DebugNodeWindow(ImGuiWindow* window, const char* label); + IMGUI_API void DebugNodeWindowSettings(ImGuiWindowSettings* settings); + IMGUI_API void DebugNodeWindowsList(ImVector* windows, const char* label); + IMGUI_API void DebugNodeViewport(ImGuiViewportP* viewport); + IMGUI_API void DebugRenderViewportThumbnail(ImDrawList* draw_list, ImGuiViewportP* viewport, const ImRect& bb); + +} // namespace ImGui + + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] ImFontAtlas internal API +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// This structure is likely to evolve as we add support for incremental atlas updates +struct ImFontBuilderIO +{ + bool (*FontBuilder_Build)(ImFontAtlas* atlas); +}; + +// Helper for font builder +IMGUI_API const ImFontBuilderIO* ImFontAtlasGetBuilderForStbTruetype(); +IMGUI_API void ImFontAtlasBuildInit(ImFontAtlas* atlas); +IMGUI_API void ImFontAtlasBuildSetupFont(ImFontAtlas* atlas, ImFont* font, ImFontConfig* font_config, float ascent, float descent); +IMGUI_API void ImFontAtlasBuildPackCustomRects(ImFontAtlas* atlas, void* stbrp_context_opaque); +IMGUI_API void ImFontAtlasBuildFinish(ImFontAtlas* atlas); +IMGUI_API void ImFontAtlasBuildRender8bppRectFromString(ImFontAtlas* atlas, int x, int y, int w, int h, const char* in_str, char in_marker_char, unsigned char in_marker_pixel_value); +IMGUI_API void ImFontAtlasBuildRender32bppRectFromString(ImFontAtlas* atlas, int x, int y, int w, int h, const char* in_str, char in_marker_char, unsigned int in_marker_pixel_value); +IMGUI_API void ImFontAtlasBuildMultiplyCalcLookupTable(unsigned char out_table[256], float in_multiply_factor); +IMGUI_API void ImFontAtlasBuildMultiplyRectAlpha8(const unsigned char table[256], unsigned char* pixels, int x, int y, int w, int h, int stride); + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Test Engine specific hooks (imgui_test_engine) +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +#ifdef IMGUI_ENABLE_TEST_ENGINE +extern void ImGuiTestEngineHook_ItemAdd(ImGuiContext* ctx, const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id); +extern void ImGuiTestEngineHook_ItemInfo(ImGuiContext* ctx, ImGuiID id, const char* label, ImGuiItemStatusFlags flags); +extern void ImGuiTestEngineHook_IdInfo(ImGuiContext* ctx, ImGuiDataType data_type, ImGuiID id, const void* data_id); +extern void ImGuiTestEngineHook_IdInfo(ImGuiContext* ctx, ImGuiDataType data_type, ImGuiID id, const void* data_id, const void* data_id_end); +extern void ImGuiTestEngineHook_Log(ImGuiContext* ctx, const char* fmt, ...); +#define IMGUI_TEST_ENGINE_ITEM_ADD(_BB,_ID) if (g.TestEngineHookItems) ImGuiTestEngineHook_ItemAdd(&g, _BB, _ID) // Register item bounding box +#define IMGUI_TEST_ENGINE_ITEM_INFO(_ID,_LABEL,_FLAGS) if (g.TestEngineHookItems) ImGuiTestEngineHook_ItemInfo(&g, _ID, _LABEL, _FLAGS) // Register item label and status flags (optional) +#define IMGUI_TEST_ENGINE_LOG(_FMT,...) if (g.TestEngineHookItems) ImGuiTestEngineHook_Log(&g, _FMT, __VA_ARGS__) // Custom log entry from user land into test log +#define IMGUI_TEST_ENGINE_ID_INFO(_ID,_TYPE,_DATA) if (g.TestEngineHookIdInfo == _ID) ImGuiTestEngineHook_IdInfo(&g, _TYPE, _ID, (const void*)(_DATA)); +#define IMGUI_TEST_ENGINE_ID_INFO2(_ID,_TYPE,_DATA,_DATA2) if (g.TestEngineHookIdInfo == _ID) ImGuiTestEngineHook_IdInfo(&g, _TYPE, _ID, (const void*)(_DATA), (const void*)(_DATA2)); +#else +#define IMGUI_TEST_ENGINE_ITEM_INFO(_ID,_LABEL,_FLAGS) ((void)0) +#endif + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +#if defined(__clang__) +#pragma clang diagnostic pop +#elif defined(__GNUC__) +#pragma GCC diagnostic pop +#endif + +#ifdef _MSC_VER +#pragma warning (pop) +#endif + +#endif // #ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE diff --git a/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/imgui-1.84.2/imgui_tables.cpp b/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/imgui-1.84.2/imgui_tables.cpp new file mode 100644 index 0000000..71ac00f --- /dev/null +++ b/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/imgui-1.84.2/imgui_tables.cpp @@ -0,0 +1,4049 @@ +// dear imgui, v1.84 +// (tables and columns code) + +/* + +Index of this file: + +// [SECTION] Commentary +// [SECTION] Header mess +// [SECTION] Tables: Main code +// [SECTION] Tables: Simple accessors +// [SECTION] Tables: Row changes +// [SECTION] Tables: Columns changes +// [SECTION] Tables: Columns width management +// [SECTION] Tables: Drawing +// [SECTION] Tables: Sorting +// [SECTION] Tables: Headers +// [SECTION] Tables: Context Menu +// [SECTION] Tables: Settings (.ini data) +// [SECTION] Tables: Garbage Collection +// [SECTION] Tables: Debugging +// [SECTION] Columns, BeginColumns, EndColumns, etc. + +*/ + +// Navigating this file: +// - In Visual Studio IDE: CTRL+comma ("Edit.NavigateTo") can follow symbols in comments, whereas CTRL+F12 ("Edit.GoToImplementation") cannot. +// - With Visual Assist installed: ALT+G ("VAssistX.GoToImplementation") can also follow symbols in comments. + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Commentary +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// Typical tables call flow: (root level is generally public API): +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// - BeginTable() user begin into a table +// | BeginChild() - (if ScrollX/ScrollY is set) +// | TableBeginInitMemory() - first time table is used +// | TableResetSettings() - on settings reset +// | TableLoadSettings() - on settings load +// | TableBeginApplyRequests() - apply queued resizing/reordering/hiding requests +// | - TableSetColumnWidth() - apply resizing width (for mouse resize, often requested by previous frame) +// | - TableUpdateColumnsWeightFromWidth()- recompute columns weights (of stretch columns) from their respective width +// - TableSetupColumn() user submit columns details (optional) +// - TableSetupScrollFreeze() user submit scroll freeze information (optional) +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// - TableUpdateLayout() [Internal] followup to BeginTable(): setup everything: widths, columns positions, clipping rectangles. Automatically called by the FIRST call to TableNextRow() or TableHeadersRow(). +// | TableSetupDrawChannels() - setup ImDrawList channels +// | TableUpdateBorders() - detect hovering columns for resize, ahead of contents submission +// | TableDrawContextMenu() - draw right-click context menu +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// - TableHeadersRow() or TableHeader() user submit a headers row (optional) +// | TableSortSpecsClickColumn() - when left-clicked: alter sort order and sort direction +// | TableOpenContextMenu() - when right-clicked: trigger opening of the default context menu +// - TableGetSortSpecs() user queries updated sort specs (optional, generally after submitting headers) +// - TableNextRow() user begin into a new row (also automatically called by TableHeadersRow()) +// | TableEndRow() - finish existing row +// | TableBeginRow() - add a new row +// - TableSetColumnIndex() / TableNextColumn() user begin into a cell +// | TableEndCell() - close existing column/cell +// | TableBeginCell() - enter into current column/cell +// - [...] user emit contents +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// - EndTable() user ends the table +// | TableDrawBorders() - draw outer borders, inner vertical borders +// | TableMergeDrawChannels() - merge draw channels if clipping isn't required +// | EndChild() - (if ScrollX/ScrollY is set) +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// TABLE SIZING +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// (Read carefully because this is subtle but it does make sense!) +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// About 'outer_size': +// Its meaning needs to differ slightly depending on if we are using ScrollX/ScrollY flags. +// Default value is ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f). +// X +// - outer_size.x <= 0.0f -> Right-align from window/work-rect right-most edge. With -FLT_MIN or 0.0f will align exactly on right-most edge. +// - outer_size.x > 0.0f -> Set Fixed width. +// Y with ScrollX/ScrollY disabled: we output table directly in current window +// - outer_size.y < 0.0f -> Bottom-align (but will auto extend, unless _NoHostExtendY is set). Not meaningful is parent window can vertically scroll. +// - outer_size.y = 0.0f -> No minimum height (but will auto extend, unless _NoHostExtendY is set) +// - outer_size.y > 0.0f -> Set Minimum height (but will auto extend, unless _NoHostExtenY is set) +// Y with ScrollX/ScrollY enabled: using a child window for scrolling +// - outer_size.y < 0.0f -> Bottom-align. Not meaningful is parent window can vertically scroll. +// - outer_size.y = 0.0f -> Bottom-align, consistent with BeginChild(). Not recommended unless table is last item in parent window. +// - outer_size.y > 0.0f -> Set Exact height. Recommended when using Scrolling on any axis. +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// Outer size is also affected by the NoHostExtendX/NoHostExtendY flags. +// Important to that note how the two flags have slightly different behaviors! +// - ImGuiTableFlags_NoHostExtendX -> Make outer width auto-fit to columns (overriding outer_size.x value). Only available when ScrollX/ScrollY are disabled and Stretch columns are not used. +// - ImGuiTableFlags_NoHostExtendY -> Make outer height stop exactly at outer_size.y (prevent auto-extending table past the limit). Only available when ScrollX/ScrollY is disabled. Data below the limit will be clipped and not visible. +// In theory ImGuiTableFlags_NoHostExtendY could be the default and any non-scrolling tables with outer_size.y != 0.0f would use exact height. +// This would be consistent but perhaps less useful and more confusing (as vertically clipped items are not easily noticeable) +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// About 'inner_width': +// With ScrollX disabled: +// - inner_width -> *ignored* +// With ScrollX enabled: +// - inner_width < 0.0f -> *illegal* fit in known width (right align from outer_size.x) <-- weird +// - inner_width = 0.0f -> fit in outer_width: Fixed size columns will take space they need (if avail, otherwise shrink down), Stretch columns becomes Fixed columns. +// - inner_width > 0.0f -> override scrolling width, generally to be larger than outer_size.x. Fixed column take space they need (if avail, otherwise shrink down), Stretch columns share remaining space! +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// Details: +// - If you want to use Stretch columns with ScrollX, you generally need to specify 'inner_width' otherwise the concept +// of "available space" doesn't make sense. +// - Even if not really useful, we allow 'inner_width < outer_size.x' for consistency and to facilitate understanding +// of what the value does. +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// COLUMNS SIZING POLICIES +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// About overriding column sizing policy and width/weight with TableSetupColumn(): +// We use a default parameter of 'init_width_or_weight == -1'. +// - with ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthFixed, init_width <= 0 (default) --> width is automatic +// - with ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthFixed, init_width > 0 (explicit) --> width is custom +// - with ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthStretch, init_weight <= 0 (default) --> weight is 1.0f +// - with ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthStretch, init_weight > 0 (explicit) --> weight is custom +// Widths are specified _without_ CellPadding. If you specify a width of 100.0f, the column will be cover (100.0f + Padding * 2.0f) +// and you can fit a 100.0f wide item in it without clipping and with full padding. +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// About default sizing policy (if you don't specify a ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthXXXX flag) +// - with Table policy ImGuiTableFlags_SizingFixedFit --> default Column policy is ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthFixed, default Width is equal to contents width +// - with Table policy ImGuiTableFlags_SizingFixedSame --> default Column policy is ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthFixed, default Width is max of all contents width +// - with Table policy ImGuiTableFlags_SizingStretchSame --> default Column policy is ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthStretch, default Weight is 1.0f +// - with Table policy ImGuiTableFlags_SizingStretchWeight --> default Column policy is ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthStretch, default Weight is proportional to contents +// Default Width and default Weight can be overridden when calling TableSetupColumn(). +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// About mixing Fixed/Auto and Stretch columns together: +// - the typical use of mixing sizing policies is: any number of LEADING Fixed columns, followed by one or two TRAILING Stretch columns. +// - using mixed policies with ScrollX does not make much sense, as using Stretch columns with ScrollX does not make much sense in the first place! +// that is, unless 'inner_width' is passed to BeginTable() to explicitly provide a total width to layout columns in. +// - when using ImGuiTableFlags_SizingFixedSame with mixed columns, only the Fixed/Auto columns will match their widths to the width of the maximum contents. +// - when using ImGuiTableFlags_SizingStretchSame with mixed columns, only the Stretch columns will match their weight/widths. +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// About using column width: +// If a column is manual resizable or has a width specified with TableSetupColumn(): +// - you may use GetContentRegionAvail().x to query the width available in a given column. +// - right-side alignment features such as SetNextItemWidth(-x) or PushItemWidth(-x) will rely on this width. +// If the column is not resizable and has no width specified with TableSetupColumn(): +// - its width will be automatic and be set to the max of items submitted. +// - therefore you generally cannot have ALL items of the columns use e.g. SetNextItemWidth(-FLT_MIN). +// - but if the column has one or more items of known/fixed size, this will become the reference width used by SetNextItemWidth(-FLT_MIN). +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// TABLES CLIPPING/CULLING +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// About clipping/culling of Rows in Tables: +// - For large numbers of rows, it is recommended you use ImGuiListClipper to only submit visible rows. +// ImGuiListClipper is reliant on the fact that rows are of equal height. +// See 'Demo->Tables->Vertical Scrolling' or 'Demo->Tables->Advanced' for a demo of using the clipper. +// - Note that auto-resizing columns don't play well with using the clipper. +// By default a table with _ScrollX but without _Resizable will have column auto-resize. +// So, if you want to use the clipper, make sure to either enable _Resizable, either setup columns width explicitly with _WidthFixed. +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// About clipping/culling of Columns in Tables: +// - Both TableSetColumnIndex() and TableNextColumn() return true when the column is visible or performing +// width measurements. Otherwise, you may skip submitting the contents of a cell/column, BUT ONLY if you know +// it is not going to contribute to row height. +// In many situations, you may skip submitting contents for every column but one (e.g. the first one). +// - Case A: column is not hidden by user, and at least partially in sight (most common case). +// - Case B: column is clipped / out of sight (because of scrolling or parent ClipRect): TableNextColumn() return false as a hint but we still allow layout output. +// - Case C: column is hidden explicitly by the user (e.g. via the context menu, or _DefaultHide column flag, etc.). +// +// [A] [B] [C] +// TableNextColumn(): true false false -> [userland] when TableNextColumn() / TableSetColumnIndex() return false, user can skip submitting items but only if the column doesn't contribute to row height. +// SkipItems: false false true -> [internal] when SkipItems is true, most widgets will early out if submitted, resulting is no layout output. +// ClipRect: normal zero-width zero-width -> [internal] when ClipRect is zero, ItemAdd() will return false and most widgets will early out mid-way. +// ImDrawList output: normal dummy dummy -> [internal] when using the dummy channel, ImDrawList submissions (if any) will be wasted (because cliprect is zero-width anyway). +// +// - We need to distinguish those cases because non-hidden columns that are clipped outside of scrolling bounds should still contribute their height to the row. +// However, in the majority of cases, the contribution to row height is the same for all columns, or the tallest cells are known by the programmer. +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// About clipping/culling of whole Tables: +// - Scrolling tables with a known outer size can be clipped earlier as BeginTable() will return false. +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Header mess +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +#if defined(_MSC_VER) && !defined(_CRT_SECURE_NO_WARNINGS) +#define _CRT_SECURE_NO_WARNINGS +#endif + +#include "imgui.h" +#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE + +#ifndef IMGUI_DEFINE_MATH_OPERATORS +#define IMGUI_DEFINE_MATH_OPERATORS +#endif +#include "imgui_internal.h" + +// System includes +#if defined(_MSC_VER) && _MSC_VER <= 1500 // MSVC 2008 or earlier +#include // intptr_t +#else +#include // intptr_t +#endif + +// Visual Studio warnings +#ifdef _MSC_VER +#pragma warning (disable: 4127) // condition expression is constant +#pragma warning (disable: 4996) // 'This function or variable may be unsafe': strcpy, strdup, sprintf, vsnprintf, sscanf, fopen +#if defined(_MSC_VER) && _MSC_VER >= 1922 // MSVC 2019 16.2 or later +#pragma warning (disable: 5054) // operator '|': deprecated between enumerations of different types +#endif +#pragma warning (disable: 26451) // [Static Analyzer] Arithmetic overflow : Using operator 'xxx' on a 4 byte value and then casting the result to a 8 byte value. Cast the value to the wider type before calling operator 'xxx' to avoid overflow(io.2). +#pragma warning (disable: 26812) // [Static Analyzer] The enum type 'xxx' is unscoped. Prefer 'enum class' over 'enum' (Enum.3). +#endif + +// Clang/GCC warnings with -Weverything +#if defined(__clang__) +#if __has_warning("-Wunknown-warning-option") +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wunknown-warning-option" // warning: unknown warning group 'xxx' // not all warnings are known by all Clang versions and they tend to be rename-happy.. so ignoring warnings triggers new warnings on some configuration. Great! +#endif +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wunknown-pragmas" // warning: unknown warning group 'xxx' +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wold-style-cast" // warning: use of old-style cast // yes, they are more terse. +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wfloat-equal" // warning: comparing floating point with == or != is unsafe // storing and comparing against same constants (typically 0.0f) is ok. +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wformat-nonliteral" // warning: format string is not a string literal // passing non-literal to vsnformat(). yes, user passing incorrect format strings can crash the code. +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wsign-conversion" // warning: implicit conversion changes signedness +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wzero-as-null-pointer-constant" // warning: zero as null pointer constant // some standard header variations use #define NULL 0 +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wdouble-promotion" // warning: implicit conversion from 'float' to 'double' when passing argument to function // using printf() is a misery with this as C++ va_arg ellipsis changes float to double. +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wenum-enum-conversion" // warning: bitwise operation between different enumeration types ('XXXFlags_' and 'XXXFlagsPrivate_') +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wdeprecated-enum-enum-conversion"// warning: bitwise operation between different enumeration types ('XXXFlags_' and 'XXXFlagsPrivate_') is deprecated +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wimplicit-int-float-conversion" // warning: implicit conversion from 'xxx' to 'float' may lose precision +#elif defined(__GNUC__) +#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wpragmas" // warning: unknown option after '#pragma GCC diagnostic' kind +#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wformat-nonliteral" // warning: format not a string literal, format string not checked +#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wclass-memaccess" // [__GNUC__ >= 8] warning: 'memset/memcpy' clearing/writing an object of type 'xxxx' with no trivial copy-assignment; use assignment or value-initialization instead +#endif + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Tables: Main code +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// - TableFixFlags() [Internal] +// - TableFindByID() [Internal] +// - BeginTable() +// - BeginTableEx() [Internal] +// - TableBeginInitMemory() [Internal] +// - TableBeginApplyRequests() [Internal] +// - TableSetupColumnFlags() [Internal] +// - TableUpdateLayout() [Internal] +// - TableUpdateBorders() [Internal] +// - EndTable() +// - TableSetupColumn() +// - TableSetupScrollFreeze() +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// Configuration +static const int TABLE_DRAW_CHANNEL_BG0 = 0; +static const int TABLE_DRAW_CHANNEL_BG2_FROZEN = 1; +static const int TABLE_DRAW_CHANNEL_NOCLIP = 2; // When using ImGuiTableFlags_NoClip (this becomes the last visible channel) +static const float TABLE_BORDER_SIZE = 1.0f; // FIXME-TABLE: Currently hard-coded because of clipping assumptions with outer borders rendering. +static const float TABLE_RESIZE_SEPARATOR_HALF_THICKNESS = 4.0f; // Extend outside inner borders. +static const float TABLE_RESIZE_SEPARATOR_FEEDBACK_TIMER = 0.06f; // Delay/timer before making the hover feedback (color+cursor) visible because tables/columns tends to be more cramped. + +// Helper +inline ImGuiTableFlags TableFixFlags(ImGuiTableFlags flags, ImGuiWindow* outer_window) +{ + // Adjust flags: set default sizing policy + if ((flags & ImGuiTableFlags_SizingMask_) == 0) + flags |= ((flags & ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollX) || (outer_window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize)) ? ImGuiTableFlags_SizingFixedFit : ImGuiTableFlags_SizingStretchSame; + + // Adjust flags: enable NoKeepColumnsVisible when using ImGuiTableFlags_SizingFixedSame + if ((flags & ImGuiTableFlags_SizingMask_) == ImGuiTableFlags_SizingFixedSame) + flags |= ImGuiTableFlags_NoKeepColumnsVisible; + + // Adjust flags: enforce borders when resizable + if (flags & ImGuiTableFlags_Resizable) + flags |= ImGuiTableFlags_BordersInnerV; + + // Adjust flags: disable NoHostExtendX/NoHostExtendY if we have any scrolling going on + if (flags & (ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollX | ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollY)) + flags &= ~(ImGuiTableFlags_NoHostExtendX | ImGuiTableFlags_NoHostExtendY); + + // Adjust flags: NoBordersInBodyUntilResize takes priority over NoBordersInBody + if (flags & ImGuiTableFlags_NoBordersInBodyUntilResize) + flags &= ~ImGuiTableFlags_NoBordersInBody; + + // Adjust flags: disable saved settings if there's nothing to save + if ((flags & (ImGuiTableFlags_Resizable | ImGuiTableFlags_Hideable | ImGuiTableFlags_Reorderable | ImGuiTableFlags_Sortable)) == 0) + flags |= ImGuiTableFlags_NoSavedSettings; + + // Inherit _NoSavedSettings from top-level window (child windows always have _NoSavedSettings set) + if (outer_window->RootWindow->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoSavedSettings) + flags |= ImGuiTableFlags_NoSavedSettings; + + return flags; +} + +ImGuiTable* ImGui::TableFindByID(ImGuiID id) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + return g.Tables.GetByKey(id); +} + +// Read about "TABLE SIZING" at the top of this file. +bool ImGui::BeginTable(const char* str_id, int columns_count, ImGuiTableFlags flags, const ImVec2& outer_size, float inner_width) +{ + ImGuiID id = GetID(str_id); + return BeginTableEx(str_id, id, columns_count, flags, outer_size, inner_width); +} + +bool ImGui::BeginTableEx(const char* name, ImGuiID id, int columns_count, ImGuiTableFlags flags, const ImVec2& outer_size, float inner_width) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* outer_window = GetCurrentWindow(); + if (outer_window->SkipItems) // Consistent with other tables + beneficial side effect that assert on miscalling EndTable() will be more visible. + return false; + + // Sanity checks + IM_ASSERT(columns_count > 0 && columns_count <= IMGUI_TABLE_MAX_COLUMNS && "Only 1..64 columns allowed!"); + if (flags & ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollX) + IM_ASSERT(inner_width >= 0.0f); + + // If an outer size is specified ahead we will be able to early out when not visible. Exact clipping rules may evolve. + const bool use_child_window = (flags & (ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollX | ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollY)) != 0; + const ImVec2 avail_size = GetContentRegionAvail(); + ImVec2 actual_outer_size = CalcItemSize(outer_size, ImMax(avail_size.x, 1.0f), use_child_window ? ImMax(avail_size.y, 1.0f) : 0.0f); + ImRect outer_rect(outer_window->DC.CursorPos, outer_window->DC.CursorPos + actual_outer_size); + if (use_child_window && IsClippedEx(outer_rect, 0, false)) + { + ItemSize(outer_rect); + return false; + } + + // Acquire storage for the table + ImGuiTable* table = g.Tables.GetOrAddByKey(id); + const int instance_no = (table->LastFrameActive != g.FrameCount) ? 0 : table->InstanceCurrent + 1; + const ImGuiID instance_id = id + instance_no; + const ImGuiTableFlags table_last_flags = table->Flags; + if (instance_no > 0) + IM_ASSERT(table->ColumnsCount == columns_count && "BeginTable(): Cannot change columns count mid-frame while preserving same ID"); + + // Acquire temporary buffers + const int table_idx = g.Tables.GetIndex(table); + g.CurrentTableStackIdx++; + if (g.CurrentTableStackIdx + 1 > g.TablesTempDataStack.Size) + g.TablesTempDataStack.resize(g.CurrentTableStackIdx + 1, ImGuiTableTempData()); + ImGuiTableTempData* temp_data = table->TempData = &g.TablesTempDataStack[g.CurrentTableStackIdx]; + temp_data->TableIndex = table_idx; + table->DrawSplitter = &table->TempData->DrawSplitter; + table->DrawSplitter->Clear(); + + // Fix flags + table->IsDefaultSizingPolicy = (flags & ImGuiTableFlags_SizingMask_) == 0; + flags = TableFixFlags(flags, outer_window); + + // Initialize + table->ID = id; + table->Flags = flags; + table->InstanceCurrent = (ImS16)instance_no; + table->LastFrameActive = g.FrameCount; + table->OuterWindow = table->InnerWindow = outer_window; + table->ColumnsCount = columns_count; + table->IsLayoutLocked = false; + table->InnerWidth = inner_width; + temp_data->UserOuterSize = outer_size; + + // When not using a child window, WorkRect.Max will grow as we append contents. + if (use_child_window) + { + // Ensure no vertical scrollbar appears if we only want horizontal one, to make flag consistent + // (we have no other way to disable vertical scrollbar of a window while keeping the horizontal one showing) + ImVec2 override_content_size(FLT_MAX, FLT_MAX); + if ((flags & ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollX) && !(flags & ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollY)) + override_content_size.y = FLT_MIN; + + // Ensure specified width (when not specified, Stretched columns will act as if the width == OuterWidth and + // never lead to any scrolling). We don't handle inner_width < 0.0f, we could potentially use it to right-align + // based on the right side of the child window work rect, which would require knowing ahead if we are going to + // have decoration taking horizontal spaces (typically a vertical scrollbar). + if ((flags & ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollX) && inner_width > 0.0f) + override_content_size.x = inner_width; + + if (override_content_size.x != FLT_MAX || override_content_size.y != FLT_MAX) + SetNextWindowContentSize(ImVec2(override_content_size.x != FLT_MAX ? override_content_size.x : 0.0f, override_content_size.y != FLT_MAX ? override_content_size.y : 0.0f)); + + // Reset scroll if we are reactivating it + if ((table_last_flags & (ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollX | ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollY)) == 0) + SetNextWindowScroll(ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f)); + + // Create scrolling region (without border and zero window padding) + ImGuiWindowFlags child_flags = (flags & ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollX) ? ImGuiWindowFlags_HorizontalScrollbar : ImGuiWindowFlags_None; + BeginChildEx(name, instance_id, outer_rect.GetSize(), false, child_flags); + table->InnerWindow = g.CurrentWindow; + table->WorkRect = table->InnerWindow->WorkRect; + table->OuterRect = table->InnerWindow->Rect(); + table->InnerRect = table->InnerWindow->InnerRect; + IM_ASSERT(table->InnerWindow->WindowPadding.x == 0.0f && table->InnerWindow->WindowPadding.y == 0.0f && table->InnerWindow->WindowBorderSize == 0.0f); + } + else + { + // For non-scrolling tables, WorkRect == OuterRect == InnerRect. + // But at this point we do NOT have a correct value for .Max.y (unless a height has been explicitly passed in). It will only be updated in EndTable(). + table->WorkRect = table->OuterRect = table->InnerRect = outer_rect; + } + + // Push a standardized ID for both child-using and not-child-using tables + PushOverrideID(instance_id); + + // Backup a copy of host window members we will modify + ImGuiWindow* inner_window = table->InnerWindow; + table->HostIndentX = inner_window->DC.Indent.x; + table->HostClipRect = inner_window->ClipRect; + table->HostSkipItems = inner_window->SkipItems; + temp_data->HostBackupWorkRect = inner_window->WorkRect; + temp_data->HostBackupParentWorkRect = inner_window->ParentWorkRect; + temp_data->HostBackupColumnsOffset = outer_window->DC.ColumnsOffset; + temp_data->HostBackupPrevLineSize = inner_window->DC.PrevLineSize; + temp_data->HostBackupCurrLineSize = inner_window->DC.CurrLineSize; + temp_data->HostBackupCursorMaxPos = inner_window->DC.CursorMaxPos; + temp_data->HostBackupItemWidth = outer_window->DC.ItemWidth; + temp_data->HostBackupItemWidthStackSize = outer_window->DC.ItemWidthStack.Size; + inner_window->DC.PrevLineSize = inner_window->DC.CurrLineSize = ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f); + + // Padding and Spacing + // - None ........Content..... Pad .....Content........ + // - PadOuter | Pad ..Content..... Pad .....Content.. Pad | + // - PadInner ........Content.. Pad | Pad ..Content........ + // - PadOuter+PadInner | Pad ..Content.. Pad | Pad ..Content.. Pad | + const bool pad_outer_x = (flags & ImGuiTableFlags_NoPadOuterX) ? false : (flags & ImGuiTableFlags_PadOuterX) ? true : (flags & ImGuiTableFlags_BordersOuterV) != 0; + const bool pad_inner_x = (flags & ImGuiTableFlags_NoPadInnerX) ? false : true; + const float inner_spacing_for_border = (flags & ImGuiTableFlags_BordersInnerV) ? TABLE_BORDER_SIZE : 0.0f; + const float inner_spacing_explicit = (pad_inner_x && (flags & ImGuiTableFlags_BordersInnerV) == 0) ? g.Style.CellPadding.x : 0.0f; + const float inner_padding_explicit = (pad_inner_x && (flags & ImGuiTableFlags_BordersInnerV) != 0) ? g.Style.CellPadding.x : 0.0f; + table->CellSpacingX1 = inner_spacing_explicit + inner_spacing_for_border; + table->CellSpacingX2 = inner_spacing_explicit; + table->CellPaddingX = inner_padding_explicit; + table->CellPaddingY = g.Style.CellPadding.y; + + const float outer_padding_for_border = (flags & ImGuiTableFlags_BordersOuterV) ? TABLE_BORDER_SIZE : 0.0f; + const float outer_padding_explicit = pad_outer_x ? g.Style.CellPadding.x : 0.0f; + table->OuterPaddingX = (outer_padding_for_border + outer_padding_explicit) - table->CellPaddingX; + + table->CurrentColumn = -1; + table->CurrentRow = -1; + table->RowBgColorCounter = 0; + table->LastRowFlags = ImGuiTableRowFlags_None; + table->InnerClipRect = (inner_window == outer_window) ? table->WorkRect : inner_window->ClipRect; + table->InnerClipRect.ClipWith(table->WorkRect); // We need this to honor inner_width + table->InnerClipRect.ClipWithFull(table->HostClipRect); + table->InnerClipRect.Max.y = (flags & ImGuiTableFlags_NoHostExtendY) ? ImMin(table->InnerClipRect.Max.y, inner_window->WorkRect.Max.y) : inner_window->ClipRect.Max.y; + + table->RowPosY1 = table->RowPosY2 = table->WorkRect.Min.y; // This is needed somehow + table->RowTextBaseline = 0.0f; // This will be cleared again by TableBeginRow() + table->FreezeRowsRequest = table->FreezeRowsCount = 0; // This will be setup by TableSetupScrollFreeze(), if any + table->FreezeColumnsRequest = table->FreezeColumnsCount = 0; + table->IsUnfrozenRows = true; + table->DeclColumnsCount = 0; + + // Using opaque colors facilitate overlapping elements of the grid + table->BorderColorStrong = GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_TableBorderStrong); + table->BorderColorLight = GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_TableBorderLight); + + // Make table current + g.CurrentTable = table; + outer_window->DC.CurrentTableIdx = table_idx; + if (inner_window != outer_window) // So EndChild() within the inner window can restore the table properly. + inner_window->DC.CurrentTableIdx = table_idx; + + if ((table_last_flags & ImGuiTableFlags_Reorderable) && (flags & ImGuiTableFlags_Reorderable) == 0) + table->IsResetDisplayOrderRequest = true; + + // Mark as used + if (table_idx >= g.TablesLastTimeActive.Size) + g.TablesLastTimeActive.resize(table_idx + 1, -1.0f); + g.TablesLastTimeActive[table_idx] = (float)g.Time; + temp_data->LastTimeActive = (float)g.Time; + table->MemoryCompacted = false; + + // Setup memory buffer (clear data if columns count changed) + ImGuiTableColumn* old_columns_to_preserve = NULL; + void* old_columns_raw_data = NULL; + const int old_columns_count = table->Columns.size(); + if (old_columns_count != 0 && old_columns_count != columns_count) + { + // Attempt to preserve width on column count change (#4046) + old_columns_to_preserve = table->Columns.Data; + old_columns_raw_data = table->RawData; + table->RawData = NULL; + } + if (table->RawData == NULL) + { + TableBeginInitMemory(table, columns_count); + table->IsInitializing = table->IsSettingsRequestLoad = true; + } + if (table->IsResetAllRequest) + TableResetSettings(table); + if (table->IsInitializing) + { + // Initialize + table->SettingsOffset = -1; + table->IsSortSpecsDirty = true; + table->InstanceInteracted = -1; + table->ContextPopupColumn = -1; + table->ReorderColumn = table->ResizedColumn = table->LastResizedColumn = -1; + table->AutoFitSingleColumn = -1; + table->HoveredColumnBody = table->HoveredColumnBorder = -1; + for (int n = 0; n < columns_count; n++) + { + ImGuiTableColumn* column = &table->Columns[n]; + if (old_columns_to_preserve && n < old_columns_count) + { + // FIXME: We don't attempt to preserve column order in this path. + *column = old_columns_to_preserve[n]; + } + else + { + float width_auto = column->WidthAuto; + *column = ImGuiTableColumn(); + column->WidthAuto = width_auto; + column->IsPreserveWidthAuto = true; // Preserve WidthAuto when reinitializing a live table: not technically necessary but remove a visible flicker + column->IsEnabled = column->IsUserEnabled = column->IsUserEnabledNextFrame = true; + } + column->DisplayOrder = table->DisplayOrderToIndex[n] = (ImGuiTableColumnIdx)n; + } + } + if (old_columns_raw_data) + IM_FREE(old_columns_raw_data); + + // Load settings + if (table->IsSettingsRequestLoad) + TableLoadSettings(table); + + // Handle DPI/font resize + // This is designed to facilitate DPI changes with the assumption that e.g. style.CellPadding has been scaled as well. + // It will also react to changing fonts with mixed results. It doesn't need to be perfect but merely provide a decent transition. + // FIXME-DPI: Provide consistent standards for reference size. Perhaps using g.CurrentDpiScale would be more self explanatory. + // This is will lead us to non-rounded WidthRequest in columns, which should work but is a poorly tested path. + const float new_ref_scale_unit = g.FontSize; // g.Font->GetCharAdvance('A') ? + if (table->RefScale != 0.0f && table->RefScale != new_ref_scale_unit) + { + const float scale_factor = new_ref_scale_unit / table->RefScale; + //IMGUI_DEBUG_LOG("[table] %08X RefScaleUnit %.3f -> %.3f, scaling width by %.3f\n", table->ID, table->RefScaleUnit, new_ref_scale_unit, scale_factor); + for (int n = 0; n < columns_count; n++) + table->Columns[n].WidthRequest = table->Columns[n].WidthRequest * scale_factor; + } + table->RefScale = new_ref_scale_unit; + + // Disable output until user calls TableNextRow() or TableNextColumn() leading to the TableUpdateLayout() call.. + // This is not strictly necessary but will reduce cases were "out of table" output will be misleading to the user. + // Because we cannot safely assert in EndTable() when no rows have been created, this seems like our best option. + inner_window->SkipItems = true; + + // Clear names + // At this point the ->NameOffset field of each column will be invalid until TableUpdateLayout() or the first call to TableSetupColumn() + if (table->ColumnsNames.Buf.Size > 0) + table->ColumnsNames.Buf.resize(0); + + // Apply queued resizing/reordering/hiding requests + TableBeginApplyRequests(table); + + return true; +} + +// For reference, the average total _allocation count_ for a table is: +// + 0 (for ImGuiTable instance, we are pooling allocations in g.Tables) +// + 1 (for table->RawData allocated below) +// + 1 (for table->ColumnsNames, if names are used) +// + 1 (for table->Splitter._Channels) +// + 2 * active_channels_count (for ImDrawCmd and ImDrawIdx buffers inside channels) +// Where active_channels_count is variable but often == columns_count or columns_count + 1, see TableSetupDrawChannels() for details. +// Unused channels don't perform their +2 allocations. +void ImGui::TableBeginInitMemory(ImGuiTable* table, int columns_count) +{ + // Allocate single buffer for our arrays + ImSpanAllocator<3> span_allocator; + span_allocator.Reserve(0, columns_count * sizeof(ImGuiTableColumn)); + span_allocator.Reserve(1, columns_count * sizeof(ImGuiTableColumnIdx)); + span_allocator.Reserve(2, columns_count * sizeof(ImGuiTableCellData), 4); + table->RawData = IM_ALLOC(span_allocator.GetArenaSizeInBytes()); + memset(table->RawData, 0, span_allocator.GetArenaSizeInBytes()); + span_allocator.SetArenaBasePtr(table->RawData); + span_allocator.GetSpan(0, &table->Columns); + span_allocator.GetSpan(1, &table->DisplayOrderToIndex); + span_allocator.GetSpan(2, &table->RowCellData); +} + +// Apply queued resizing/reordering/hiding requests +void ImGui::TableBeginApplyRequests(ImGuiTable* table) +{ + // Handle resizing request + // (We process this at the first TableBegin of the frame) + // FIXME-TABLE: Contains columns if our work area doesn't allow for scrolling? + if (table->InstanceCurrent == 0) + { + if (table->ResizedColumn != -1 && table->ResizedColumnNextWidth != FLT_MAX) + TableSetColumnWidth(table->ResizedColumn, table->ResizedColumnNextWidth); + table->LastResizedColumn = table->ResizedColumn; + table->ResizedColumnNextWidth = FLT_MAX; + table->ResizedColumn = -1; + + // Process auto-fit for single column, which is a special case for stretch columns and fixed columns with FixedSame policy. + // FIXME-TABLE: Would be nice to redistribute available stretch space accordingly to other weights, instead of giving it all to siblings. + if (table->AutoFitSingleColumn != -1) + { + TableSetColumnWidth(table->AutoFitSingleColumn, table->Columns[table->AutoFitSingleColumn].WidthAuto); + table->AutoFitSingleColumn = -1; + } + } + + // Handle reordering request + // Note: we don't clear ReorderColumn after handling the request. + if (table->InstanceCurrent == 0) + { + if (table->HeldHeaderColumn == -1 && table->ReorderColumn != -1) + table->ReorderColumn = -1; + table->HeldHeaderColumn = -1; + if (table->ReorderColumn != -1 && table->ReorderColumnDir != 0) + { + // We need to handle reordering across hidden columns. + // In the configuration below, moving C to the right of E will lead to: + // ... C [D] E ---> ... [D] E C (Column name/index) + // ... 2 3 4 ... 2 3 4 (Display order) + const int reorder_dir = table->ReorderColumnDir; + IM_ASSERT(reorder_dir == -1 || reorder_dir == +1); + IM_ASSERT(table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_Reorderable); + ImGuiTableColumn* src_column = &table->Columns[table->ReorderColumn]; + ImGuiTableColumn* dst_column = &table->Columns[(reorder_dir == -1) ? src_column->PrevEnabledColumn : src_column->NextEnabledColumn]; + IM_UNUSED(dst_column); + const int src_order = src_column->DisplayOrder; + const int dst_order = dst_column->DisplayOrder; + src_column->DisplayOrder = (ImGuiTableColumnIdx)dst_order; + for (int order_n = src_order + reorder_dir; order_n != dst_order + reorder_dir; order_n += reorder_dir) + table->Columns[table->DisplayOrderToIndex[order_n]].DisplayOrder -= (ImGuiTableColumnIdx)reorder_dir; + IM_ASSERT(dst_column->DisplayOrder == dst_order - reorder_dir); + + // Display order is stored in both columns->IndexDisplayOrder and table->DisplayOrder[], + // rebuild the later from the former. + for (int column_n = 0; column_n < table->ColumnsCount; column_n++) + table->DisplayOrderToIndex[table->Columns[column_n].DisplayOrder] = (ImGuiTableColumnIdx)column_n; + table->ReorderColumnDir = 0; + table->IsSettingsDirty = true; + } + } + + // Handle display order reset request + if (table->IsResetDisplayOrderRequest) + { + for (int n = 0; n < table->ColumnsCount; n++) + table->DisplayOrderToIndex[n] = table->Columns[n].DisplayOrder = (ImGuiTableColumnIdx)n; + table->IsResetDisplayOrderRequest = false; + table->IsSettingsDirty = true; + } +} + +// Adjust flags: default width mode + stretch columns are not allowed when auto extending +static void TableSetupColumnFlags(ImGuiTable* table, ImGuiTableColumn* column, ImGuiTableColumnFlags flags_in) +{ + ImGuiTableColumnFlags flags = flags_in; + + // Sizing Policy + if ((flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthMask_) == 0) + { + const ImGuiTableFlags table_sizing_policy = (table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_SizingMask_); + if (table_sizing_policy == ImGuiTableFlags_SizingFixedFit || table_sizing_policy == ImGuiTableFlags_SizingFixedSame) + flags |= ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthFixed; + else + flags |= ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthStretch; + } + else + { + IM_ASSERT(ImIsPowerOfTwo(flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthMask_)); // Check that only 1 of each set is used. + } + + // Resize + if ((table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_Resizable) == 0) + flags |= ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoResize; + + // Sorting + if ((flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoSortAscending) && (flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoSortDescending)) + flags |= ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoSort; + + // Indentation + if ((flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_IndentMask_) == 0) + flags |= (table->Columns.index_from_ptr(column) == 0) ? ImGuiTableColumnFlags_IndentEnable : ImGuiTableColumnFlags_IndentDisable; + + // Alignment + //if ((flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_AlignMask_) == 0) + // flags |= ImGuiTableColumnFlags_AlignCenter; + //IM_ASSERT(ImIsPowerOfTwo(flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_AlignMask_)); // Check that only 1 of each set is used. + + // Preserve status flags + column->Flags = flags | (column->Flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_StatusMask_); + + // Build an ordered list of available sort directions + column->SortDirectionsAvailCount = column->SortDirectionsAvailMask = column->SortDirectionsAvailList = 0; + if (table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_Sortable) + { + int count = 0, mask = 0, list = 0; + if ((flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_PreferSortAscending) != 0 && (flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoSortAscending) == 0) { mask |= 1 << ImGuiSortDirection_Ascending; list |= ImGuiSortDirection_Ascending << (count << 1); count++; } + if ((flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_PreferSortDescending) != 0 && (flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoSortDescending) == 0) { mask |= 1 << ImGuiSortDirection_Descending; list |= ImGuiSortDirection_Descending << (count << 1); count++; } + if ((flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_PreferSortAscending) == 0 && (flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoSortAscending) == 0) { mask |= 1 << ImGuiSortDirection_Ascending; list |= ImGuiSortDirection_Ascending << (count << 1); count++; } + if ((flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_PreferSortDescending) == 0 && (flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoSortDescending) == 0) { mask |= 1 << ImGuiSortDirection_Descending; list |= ImGuiSortDirection_Descending << (count << 1); count++; } + if ((table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_SortTristate) || count == 0) { mask |= 1 << ImGuiSortDirection_None; count++; } + column->SortDirectionsAvailList = (ImU8)list; + column->SortDirectionsAvailMask = (ImU8)mask; + column->SortDirectionsAvailCount = (ImU8)count; + ImGui::TableFixColumnSortDirection(table, column); + } +} + +// Layout columns for the frame. This is in essence the followup to BeginTable(). +// Runs on the first call to TableNextRow(), to give a chance for TableSetupColumn() to be called first. +// FIXME-TABLE: Our width (and therefore our WorkRect) will be minimal in the first frame for _WidthAuto columns. +// Increase feedback side-effect with widgets relying on WorkRect.Max.x... Maybe provide a default distribution for _WidthAuto columns? +void ImGui::TableUpdateLayout(ImGuiTable* table) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + IM_ASSERT(table->IsLayoutLocked == false); + + const ImGuiTableFlags table_sizing_policy = (table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_SizingMask_); + table->IsDefaultDisplayOrder = true; + table->ColumnsEnabledCount = 0; + table->EnabledMaskByIndex = 0x00; + table->EnabledMaskByDisplayOrder = 0x00; + table->LeftMostEnabledColumn = -1; + table->MinColumnWidth = ImMax(1.0f, g.Style.FramePadding.x * 1.0f); // g.Style.ColumnsMinSpacing; // FIXME-TABLE + + // [Part 1] Apply/lock Enabled and Order states. Calculate auto/ideal width for columns. Count fixed/stretch columns. + // Process columns in their visible orders as we are building the Prev/Next indices. + int count_fixed = 0; // Number of columns that have fixed sizing policies + int count_stretch = 0; // Number of columns that have stretch sizing policies + int prev_visible_column_idx = -1; + bool has_auto_fit_request = false; + bool has_resizable = false; + float stretch_sum_width_auto = 0.0f; + float fixed_max_width_auto = 0.0f; + for (int order_n = 0; order_n < table->ColumnsCount; order_n++) + { + const int column_n = table->DisplayOrderToIndex[order_n]; + if (column_n != order_n) + table->IsDefaultDisplayOrder = false; + ImGuiTableColumn* column = &table->Columns[column_n]; + + // Clear column setup if not submitted by user. Currently we make it mandatory to call TableSetupColumn() every frame. + // It would easily work without but we're not ready to guarantee it since e.g. names need resubmission anyway. + // We take a slight shortcut but in theory we could be calling TableSetupColumn() here with dummy values, it should yield the same effect. + if (table->DeclColumnsCount <= column_n) + { + TableSetupColumnFlags(table, column, ImGuiTableColumnFlags_None); + column->NameOffset = -1; + column->UserID = 0; + column->InitStretchWeightOrWidth = -1.0f; + } + + // Update Enabled state, mark settings and sort specs dirty + if (!(table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_Hideable) || (column->Flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoHide)) + column->IsUserEnabledNextFrame = true; + if (column->IsUserEnabled != column->IsUserEnabledNextFrame) + { + column->IsUserEnabled = column->IsUserEnabledNextFrame; + table->IsSettingsDirty = true; + } + column->IsEnabled = column->IsUserEnabled && (column->Flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_Disabled) == 0; + + if (column->SortOrder != -1 && !column->IsEnabled) + table->IsSortSpecsDirty = true; + if (column->SortOrder > 0 && !(table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_SortMulti)) + table->IsSortSpecsDirty = true; + + // Auto-fit unsized columns + const bool start_auto_fit = (column->Flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthFixed) ? (column->WidthRequest < 0.0f) : (column->StretchWeight < 0.0f); + if (start_auto_fit) + column->AutoFitQueue = column->CannotSkipItemsQueue = (1 << 3) - 1; // Fit for three frames + + if (!column->IsEnabled) + { + column->IndexWithinEnabledSet = -1; + continue; + } + + // Mark as enabled and link to previous/next enabled column + column->PrevEnabledColumn = (ImGuiTableColumnIdx)prev_visible_column_idx; + column->NextEnabledColumn = -1; + if (prev_visible_column_idx != -1) + table->Columns[prev_visible_column_idx].NextEnabledColumn = (ImGuiTableColumnIdx)column_n; + else + table->LeftMostEnabledColumn = (ImGuiTableColumnIdx)column_n; + column->IndexWithinEnabledSet = table->ColumnsEnabledCount++; + table->EnabledMaskByIndex |= (ImU64)1 << column_n; + table->EnabledMaskByDisplayOrder |= (ImU64)1 << column->DisplayOrder; + prev_visible_column_idx = column_n; + IM_ASSERT(column->IndexWithinEnabledSet <= column->DisplayOrder); + + // Calculate ideal/auto column width (that's the width required for all contents to be visible without clipping) + // Combine width from regular rows + width from headers unless requested not to. + if (!column->IsPreserveWidthAuto) + column->WidthAuto = TableGetColumnWidthAuto(table, column); + + // Non-resizable columns keep their requested width (apply user value regardless of IsPreserveWidthAuto) + const bool column_is_resizable = (column->Flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoResize) == 0; + if (column_is_resizable) + has_resizable = true; + if ((column->Flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthFixed) && column->InitStretchWeightOrWidth > 0.0f && !column_is_resizable) + column->WidthAuto = column->InitStretchWeightOrWidth; + + if (column->AutoFitQueue != 0x00) + has_auto_fit_request = true; + if (column->Flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthStretch) + { + stretch_sum_width_auto += column->WidthAuto; + count_stretch++; + } + else + { + fixed_max_width_auto = ImMax(fixed_max_width_auto, column->WidthAuto); + count_fixed++; + } + } + if ((table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_Sortable) && table->SortSpecsCount == 0 && !(table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_SortTristate)) + table->IsSortSpecsDirty = true; + table->RightMostEnabledColumn = (ImGuiTableColumnIdx)prev_visible_column_idx; + IM_ASSERT(table->LeftMostEnabledColumn >= 0 && table->RightMostEnabledColumn >= 0); + + // [Part 2] Disable child window clipping while fitting columns. This is not strictly necessary but makes it possible + // to avoid the column fitting having to wait until the first visible frame of the child container (may or not be a good thing). + // FIXME-TABLE: for always auto-resizing columns may not want to do that all the time. + if (has_auto_fit_request && table->OuterWindow != table->InnerWindow) + table->InnerWindow->SkipItems = false; + if (has_auto_fit_request) + table->IsSettingsDirty = true; + + // [Part 3] Fix column flags and record a few extra information. + float sum_width_requests = 0.0f; // Sum of all width for fixed and auto-resize columns, excluding width contributed by Stretch columns but including spacing/padding. + float stretch_sum_weights = 0.0f; // Sum of all weights for stretch columns. + table->LeftMostStretchedColumn = table->RightMostStretchedColumn = -1; + for (int column_n = 0; column_n < table->ColumnsCount; column_n++) + { + if (!(table->EnabledMaskByIndex & ((ImU64)1 << column_n))) + continue; + ImGuiTableColumn* column = &table->Columns[column_n]; + + const bool column_is_resizable = (column->Flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoResize) == 0; + if (column->Flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthFixed) + { + // Apply same widths policy + float width_auto = column->WidthAuto; + if (table_sizing_policy == ImGuiTableFlags_SizingFixedSame && (column->AutoFitQueue != 0x00 || !column_is_resizable)) + width_auto = fixed_max_width_auto; + + // Apply automatic width + // Latch initial size for fixed columns and update it constantly for auto-resizing column (unless clipped!) + if (column->AutoFitQueue != 0x00) + column->WidthRequest = width_auto; + else if ((column->Flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthFixed) && !column_is_resizable && (table->RequestOutputMaskByIndex & ((ImU64)1 << column_n))) + column->WidthRequest = width_auto; + + // FIXME-TABLE: Increase minimum size during init frame to avoid biasing auto-fitting widgets + // (e.g. TextWrapped) too much. Otherwise what tends to happen is that TextWrapped would output a very + // large height (= first frame scrollbar display very off + clipper would skip lots of items). + // This is merely making the side-effect less extreme, but doesn't properly fixes it. + // FIXME: Move this to ->WidthGiven to avoid temporary lossyless? + // FIXME: This break IsPreserveWidthAuto from not flickering if the stored WidthAuto was smaller. + if (column->AutoFitQueue > 0x01 && table->IsInitializing && !column->IsPreserveWidthAuto) + column->WidthRequest = ImMax(column->WidthRequest, table->MinColumnWidth * 4.0f); // FIXME-TABLE: Another constant/scale? + sum_width_requests += column->WidthRequest; + } + else + { + // Initialize stretch weight + if (column->AutoFitQueue != 0x00 || column->StretchWeight < 0.0f || !column_is_resizable) + { + if (column->InitStretchWeightOrWidth > 0.0f) + column->StretchWeight = column->InitStretchWeightOrWidth; + else if (table_sizing_policy == ImGuiTableFlags_SizingStretchProp) + column->StretchWeight = (column->WidthAuto / stretch_sum_width_auto) * count_stretch; + else + column->StretchWeight = 1.0f; + } + + stretch_sum_weights += column->StretchWeight; + if (table->LeftMostStretchedColumn == -1 || table->Columns[table->LeftMostStretchedColumn].DisplayOrder > column->DisplayOrder) + table->LeftMostStretchedColumn = (ImGuiTableColumnIdx)column_n; + if (table->RightMostStretchedColumn == -1 || table->Columns[table->RightMostStretchedColumn].DisplayOrder < column->DisplayOrder) + table->RightMostStretchedColumn = (ImGuiTableColumnIdx)column_n; + } + column->IsPreserveWidthAuto = false; + sum_width_requests += table->CellPaddingX * 2.0f; + } + table->ColumnsEnabledFixedCount = (ImGuiTableColumnIdx)count_fixed; + + // [Part 4] Apply final widths based on requested widths + const ImRect work_rect = table->WorkRect; + const float width_spacings = (table->OuterPaddingX * 2.0f) + (table->CellSpacingX1 + table->CellSpacingX2) * (table->ColumnsEnabledCount - 1); + const float width_avail = ((table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollX) && table->InnerWidth == 0.0f) ? table->InnerClipRect.GetWidth() : work_rect.GetWidth(); + const float width_avail_for_stretched_columns = width_avail - width_spacings - sum_width_requests; + float width_remaining_for_stretched_columns = width_avail_for_stretched_columns; + table->ColumnsGivenWidth = width_spacings + (table->CellPaddingX * 2.0f) * table->ColumnsEnabledCount; + for (int column_n = 0; column_n < table->ColumnsCount; column_n++) + { + if (!(table->EnabledMaskByIndex & ((ImU64)1 << column_n))) + continue; + ImGuiTableColumn* column = &table->Columns[column_n]; + + // Allocate width for stretched/weighted columns (StretchWeight gets converted into WidthRequest) + if (column->Flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthStretch) + { + float weight_ratio = column->StretchWeight / stretch_sum_weights; + column->WidthRequest = IM_FLOOR(ImMax(width_avail_for_stretched_columns * weight_ratio, table->MinColumnWidth) + 0.01f); + width_remaining_for_stretched_columns -= column->WidthRequest; + } + + // [Resize Rule 1] The right-most Visible column is not resizable if there is at least one Stretch column + // See additional comments in TableSetColumnWidth(). + if (column->NextEnabledColumn == -1 && table->LeftMostStretchedColumn != -1) + column->Flags |= ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoDirectResize_; + + // Assign final width, record width in case we will need to shrink + column->WidthGiven = ImFloor(ImMax(column->WidthRequest, table->MinColumnWidth)); + table->ColumnsGivenWidth += column->WidthGiven; + } + + // [Part 5] Redistribute stretch remainder width due to rounding (remainder width is < 1.0f * number of Stretch column). + // Using right-to-left distribution (more likely to match resizing cursor). + if (width_remaining_for_stretched_columns >= 1.0f && !(table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_PreciseWidths)) + for (int order_n = table->ColumnsCount - 1; stretch_sum_weights > 0.0f && width_remaining_for_stretched_columns >= 1.0f && order_n >= 0; order_n--) + { + if (!(table->EnabledMaskByDisplayOrder & ((ImU64)1 << order_n))) + continue; + ImGuiTableColumn* column = &table->Columns[table->DisplayOrderToIndex[order_n]]; + if (!(column->Flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthStretch)) + continue; + column->WidthRequest += 1.0f; + column->WidthGiven += 1.0f; + width_remaining_for_stretched_columns -= 1.0f; + } + + table->HoveredColumnBody = -1; + table->HoveredColumnBorder = -1; + const ImRect mouse_hit_rect(table->OuterRect.Min.x, table->OuterRect.Min.y, table->OuterRect.Max.x, ImMax(table->OuterRect.Max.y, table->OuterRect.Min.y + table->LastOuterHeight)); + const bool is_hovering_table = ItemHoverable(mouse_hit_rect, 0); + + // [Part 6] Setup final position, offset, skip/clip states and clipping rectangles, detect hovered column + // Process columns in their visible orders as we are comparing the visible order and adjusting host_clip_rect while looping. + int visible_n = 0; + bool offset_x_frozen = (table->FreezeColumnsCount > 0); + float offset_x = ((table->FreezeColumnsCount > 0) ? table->OuterRect.Min.x : work_rect.Min.x) + table->OuterPaddingX - table->CellSpacingX1; + ImRect host_clip_rect = table->InnerClipRect; + //host_clip_rect.Max.x += table->CellPaddingX + table->CellSpacingX2; + table->VisibleMaskByIndex = 0x00; + table->RequestOutputMaskByIndex = 0x00; + for (int order_n = 0; order_n < table->ColumnsCount; order_n++) + { + const int column_n = table->DisplayOrderToIndex[order_n]; + ImGuiTableColumn* column = &table->Columns[column_n]; + + column->NavLayerCurrent = (ImS8)((table->FreezeRowsCount > 0 || column_n < table->FreezeColumnsCount) ? ImGuiNavLayer_Menu : ImGuiNavLayer_Main); + + if (offset_x_frozen && table->FreezeColumnsCount == visible_n) + { + offset_x += work_rect.Min.x - table->OuterRect.Min.x; + offset_x_frozen = false; + } + + // Clear status flags + column->Flags &= ~ImGuiTableColumnFlags_StatusMask_; + + if ((table->EnabledMaskByDisplayOrder & ((ImU64)1 << order_n)) == 0) + { + // Hidden column: clear a few fields and we are done with it for the remainder of the function. + // We set a zero-width clip rect but set Min.y/Max.y properly to not interfere with the clipper. + column->MinX = column->MaxX = column->WorkMinX = column->ClipRect.Min.x = column->ClipRect.Max.x = offset_x; + column->WidthGiven = 0.0f; + column->ClipRect.Min.y = work_rect.Min.y; + column->ClipRect.Max.y = FLT_MAX; + column->ClipRect.ClipWithFull(host_clip_rect); + column->IsVisibleX = column->IsVisibleY = column->IsRequestOutput = false; + column->IsSkipItems = true; + column->ItemWidth = 1.0f; + continue; + } + + // Detect hovered column + if (is_hovering_table && g.IO.MousePos.x >= column->ClipRect.Min.x && g.IO.MousePos.x < column->ClipRect.Max.x) + table->HoveredColumnBody = (ImGuiTableColumnIdx)column_n; + + // Lock start position + column->MinX = offset_x; + + // Lock width based on start position and minimum/maximum width for this position + float max_width = TableGetMaxColumnWidth(table, column_n); + column->WidthGiven = ImMin(column->WidthGiven, max_width); + column->WidthGiven = ImMax(column->WidthGiven, ImMin(column->WidthRequest, table->MinColumnWidth)); + column->MaxX = offset_x + column->WidthGiven + table->CellSpacingX1 + table->CellSpacingX2 + table->CellPaddingX * 2.0f; + + // Lock other positions + // - ClipRect.Min.x: Because merging draw commands doesn't compare min boundaries, we make ClipRect.Min.x match left bounds to be consistent regardless of merging. + // - ClipRect.Max.x: using WorkMaxX instead of MaxX (aka including padding) makes things more consistent when resizing down, tho slightly detrimental to visibility in very-small column. + // - ClipRect.Max.x: using MaxX makes it easier for header to receive hover highlight with no discontinuity and display sorting arrow. + // - FIXME-TABLE: We want equal width columns to have equal (ClipRect.Max.x - WorkMinX) width, which means ClipRect.max.x cannot stray off host_clip_rect.Max.x else right-most column may appear shorter. + column->WorkMinX = column->MinX + table->CellPaddingX + table->CellSpacingX1; + column->WorkMaxX = column->MaxX - table->CellPaddingX - table->CellSpacingX2; // Expected max + column->ItemWidth = ImFloor(column->WidthGiven * 0.65f); + column->ClipRect.Min.x = column->MinX; + column->ClipRect.Min.y = work_rect.Min.y; + column->ClipRect.Max.x = column->MaxX; //column->WorkMaxX; + column->ClipRect.Max.y = FLT_MAX; + column->ClipRect.ClipWithFull(host_clip_rect); + + // Mark column as Clipped (not in sight) + // Note that scrolling tables (where inner_window != outer_window) handle Y clipped earlier in BeginTable() so IsVisibleY really only applies to non-scrolling tables. + // FIXME-TABLE: Because InnerClipRect.Max.y is conservatively ==outer_window->ClipRect.Max.y, we never can mark columns _Above_ the scroll line as not IsVisibleY. + // Taking advantage of LastOuterHeight would yield good results there... + // FIXME-TABLE: Y clipping is disabled because it effectively means not submitting will reduce contents width which is fed to outer_window->DC.CursorMaxPos.x, + // and this may be used (e.g. typically by outer_window using AlwaysAutoResize or outer_window's horizontal scrollbar, but could be something else). + // Possible solution to preserve last known content width for clipped column. Test 'table_reported_size' fails when enabling Y clipping and window is resized small. + column->IsVisibleX = (column->ClipRect.Max.x > column->ClipRect.Min.x); + column->IsVisibleY = true; // (column->ClipRect.Max.y > column->ClipRect.Min.y); + const bool is_visible = column->IsVisibleX; //&& column->IsVisibleY; + if (is_visible) + table->VisibleMaskByIndex |= ((ImU64)1 << column_n); + + // Mark column as requesting output from user. Note that fixed + non-resizable sets are auto-fitting at all times and therefore always request output. + column->IsRequestOutput = is_visible || column->AutoFitQueue != 0 || column->CannotSkipItemsQueue != 0; + if (column->IsRequestOutput) + table->RequestOutputMaskByIndex |= ((ImU64)1 << column_n); + + // Mark column as SkipItems (ignoring all items/layout) + column->IsSkipItems = !column->IsEnabled || table->HostSkipItems; + if (column->IsSkipItems) + IM_ASSERT(!is_visible); + + // Update status flags + column->Flags |= ImGuiTableColumnFlags_IsEnabled; + if (is_visible) + column->Flags |= ImGuiTableColumnFlags_IsVisible; + if (column->SortOrder != -1) + column->Flags |= ImGuiTableColumnFlags_IsSorted; + if (table->HoveredColumnBody == column_n) + column->Flags |= ImGuiTableColumnFlags_IsHovered; + + // Alignment + // FIXME-TABLE: This align based on the whole column width, not per-cell, and therefore isn't useful in + // many cases (to be able to honor this we might be able to store a log of cells width, per row, for + // visible rows, but nav/programmatic scroll would have visible artifacts.) + //if (column->Flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_AlignRight) + // column->WorkMinX = ImMax(column->WorkMinX, column->MaxX - column->ContentWidthRowsUnfrozen); + //else if (column->Flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_AlignCenter) + // column->WorkMinX = ImLerp(column->WorkMinX, ImMax(column->StartX, column->MaxX - column->ContentWidthRowsUnfrozen), 0.5f); + + // Reset content width variables + column->ContentMaxXFrozen = column->ContentMaxXUnfrozen = column->WorkMinX; + column->ContentMaxXHeadersUsed = column->ContentMaxXHeadersIdeal = column->WorkMinX; + + // Don't decrement auto-fit counters until container window got a chance to submit its items + if (table->HostSkipItems == false) + { + column->AutoFitQueue >>= 1; + column->CannotSkipItemsQueue >>= 1; + } + + if (visible_n < table->FreezeColumnsCount) + host_clip_rect.Min.x = ImClamp(column->MaxX + TABLE_BORDER_SIZE, host_clip_rect.Min.x, host_clip_rect.Max.x); + + offset_x += column->WidthGiven + table->CellSpacingX1 + table->CellSpacingX2 + table->CellPaddingX * 2.0f; + visible_n++; + } + + // [Part 7] Detect/store when we are hovering the unused space after the right-most column (so e.g. context menus can react on it) + // Clear Resizable flag if none of our column are actually resizable (either via an explicit _NoResize flag, either + // because of using _WidthAuto/_WidthStretch). This will hide the resizing option from the context menu. + const float unused_x1 = ImMax(table->WorkRect.Min.x, table->Columns[table->RightMostEnabledColumn].ClipRect.Max.x); + if (is_hovering_table && table->HoveredColumnBody == -1) + { + if (g.IO.MousePos.x >= unused_x1) + table->HoveredColumnBody = (ImGuiTableColumnIdx)table->ColumnsCount; + } + if (has_resizable == false && (table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_Resizable)) + table->Flags &= ~ImGuiTableFlags_Resizable; + + // [Part 8] Lock actual OuterRect/WorkRect right-most position. + // This is done late to handle the case of fixed-columns tables not claiming more widths that they need. + // Because of this we are careful with uses of WorkRect and InnerClipRect before this point. + if (table->RightMostStretchedColumn != -1) + table->Flags &= ~ImGuiTableFlags_NoHostExtendX; + if (table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_NoHostExtendX) + { + table->OuterRect.Max.x = table->WorkRect.Max.x = unused_x1; + table->InnerClipRect.Max.x = ImMin(table->InnerClipRect.Max.x, unused_x1); + } + table->InnerWindow->ParentWorkRect = table->WorkRect; + table->BorderX1 = table->InnerClipRect.Min.x;// +((table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_BordersOuter) ? 0.0f : -1.0f); + table->BorderX2 = table->InnerClipRect.Max.x;// +((table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_BordersOuter) ? 0.0f : +1.0f); + + // [Part 9] Allocate draw channels and setup background cliprect + TableSetupDrawChannels(table); + + // [Part 10] Hit testing on borders + if (table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_Resizable) + TableUpdateBorders(table); + table->LastFirstRowHeight = 0.0f; + table->IsLayoutLocked = true; + table->IsUsingHeaders = false; + + // [Part 11] Context menu + if (table->IsContextPopupOpen && table->InstanceCurrent == table->InstanceInteracted) + { + const ImGuiID context_menu_id = ImHashStr("##ContextMenu", 0, table->ID); + if (BeginPopupEx(context_menu_id, ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoSavedSettings)) + { + TableDrawContextMenu(table); + EndPopup(); + } + else + { + table->IsContextPopupOpen = false; + } + } + + // [Part 13] Sanitize and build sort specs before we have a change to use them for display. + // This path will only be exercised when sort specs are modified before header rows (e.g. init or visibility change) + if (table->IsSortSpecsDirty && (table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_Sortable)) + TableSortSpecsBuild(table); + + // Initial state + ImGuiWindow* inner_window = table->InnerWindow; + if (table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_NoClip) + table->DrawSplitter->SetCurrentChannel(inner_window->DrawList, TABLE_DRAW_CHANNEL_NOCLIP); + else + inner_window->DrawList->PushClipRect(inner_window->ClipRect.Min, inner_window->ClipRect.Max, false); +} + +// Process hit-testing on resizing borders. Actual size change will be applied in EndTable() +// - Set table->HoveredColumnBorder with a short delay/timer to reduce feedback noise +// - Submit ahead of table contents and header, use ImGuiButtonFlags_AllowItemOverlap to prioritize widgets +// overlapping the same area. +void ImGui::TableUpdateBorders(ImGuiTable* table) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + IM_ASSERT(table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_Resizable); + + // At this point OuterRect height may be zero or under actual final height, so we rely on temporal coherency and + // use the final height from last frame. Because this is only affecting _interaction_ with columns, it is not + // really problematic (whereas the actual visual will be displayed in EndTable() and using the current frame height). + // Actual columns highlight/render will be performed in EndTable() and not be affected. + const float hit_half_width = TABLE_RESIZE_SEPARATOR_HALF_THICKNESS; + const float hit_y1 = table->OuterRect.Min.y; + const float hit_y2_body = ImMax(table->OuterRect.Max.y, hit_y1 + table->LastOuterHeight); + const float hit_y2_head = hit_y1 + table->LastFirstRowHeight; + + for (int order_n = 0; order_n < table->ColumnsCount; order_n++) + { + if (!(table->EnabledMaskByDisplayOrder & ((ImU64)1 << order_n))) + continue; + + const int column_n = table->DisplayOrderToIndex[order_n]; + ImGuiTableColumn* column = &table->Columns[column_n]; + if (column->Flags & (ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoResize | ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoDirectResize_)) + continue; + + // ImGuiTableFlags_NoBordersInBodyUntilResize will be honored in TableDrawBorders() + const float border_y2_hit = (table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_NoBordersInBody) ? hit_y2_head : hit_y2_body; + if ((table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_NoBordersInBody) && table->IsUsingHeaders == false) + continue; + + if (!column->IsVisibleX && table->LastResizedColumn != column_n) + continue; + + ImGuiID column_id = TableGetColumnResizeID(table, column_n, table->InstanceCurrent); + ImRect hit_rect(column->MaxX - hit_half_width, hit_y1, column->MaxX + hit_half_width, border_y2_hit); + //GetForegroundDrawList()->AddRect(hit_rect.Min, hit_rect.Max, IM_COL32(255, 0, 0, 100)); + KeepAliveID(column_id); + + bool hovered = false, held = false; + bool pressed = ButtonBehavior(hit_rect, column_id, &hovered, &held, ImGuiButtonFlags_FlattenChildren | ImGuiButtonFlags_AllowItemOverlap | ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClick | ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnDoubleClick); + if (pressed && IsMouseDoubleClicked(0)) + { + TableSetColumnWidthAutoSingle(table, column_n); + ClearActiveID(); + held = hovered = false; + } + if (held) + { + if (table->LastResizedColumn == -1) + table->ResizeLockMinContentsX2 = table->RightMostEnabledColumn != -1 ? table->Columns[table->RightMostEnabledColumn].MaxX : -FLT_MAX; + table->ResizedColumn = (ImGuiTableColumnIdx)column_n; + table->InstanceInteracted = table->InstanceCurrent; + } + if ((hovered && g.HoveredIdTimer > TABLE_RESIZE_SEPARATOR_FEEDBACK_TIMER) || held) + { + table->HoveredColumnBorder = (ImGuiTableColumnIdx)column_n; + SetMouseCursor(ImGuiMouseCursor_ResizeEW); + } + } +} + +void ImGui::EndTable() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiTable* table = g.CurrentTable; + IM_ASSERT(table != NULL && "Only call EndTable() if BeginTable() returns true!"); + + // This assert would be very useful to catch a common error... unfortunately it would probably trigger in some + // cases, and for consistency user may sometimes output empty tables (and still benefit from e.g. outer border) + //IM_ASSERT(table->IsLayoutLocked && "Table unused: never called TableNextRow(), is that the intent?"); + + // If the user never got to call TableNextRow() or TableNextColumn(), we call layout ourselves to ensure all our + // code paths are consistent (instead of just hoping that TableBegin/TableEnd will work), get borders drawn, etc. + if (!table->IsLayoutLocked) + TableUpdateLayout(table); + + const ImGuiTableFlags flags = table->Flags; + ImGuiWindow* inner_window = table->InnerWindow; + ImGuiWindow* outer_window = table->OuterWindow; + ImGuiTableTempData* temp_data = table->TempData; + IM_ASSERT(inner_window == g.CurrentWindow); + IM_ASSERT(outer_window == inner_window || outer_window == inner_window->ParentWindow); + + if (table->IsInsideRow) + TableEndRow(table); + + // Context menu in columns body + if (flags & ImGuiTableFlags_ContextMenuInBody) + if (table->HoveredColumnBody != -1 && !IsAnyItemHovered() && IsMouseReleased(ImGuiMouseButton_Right)) + TableOpenContextMenu((int)table->HoveredColumnBody); + + // Finalize table height + inner_window->DC.PrevLineSize = temp_data->HostBackupPrevLineSize; + inner_window->DC.CurrLineSize = temp_data->HostBackupCurrLineSize; + inner_window->DC.CursorMaxPos = temp_data->HostBackupCursorMaxPos; + const float inner_content_max_y = table->RowPosY2; + IM_ASSERT(table->RowPosY2 == inner_window->DC.CursorPos.y); + if (inner_window != outer_window) + inner_window->DC.CursorMaxPos.y = inner_content_max_y; + else if (!(flags & ImGuiTableFlags_NoHostExtendY)) + table->OuterRect.Max.y = table->InnerRect.Max.y = ImMax(table->OuterRect.Max.y, inner_content_max_y); // Patch OuterRect/InnerRect height + table->WorkRect.Max.y = ImMax(table->WorkRect.Max.y, table->OuterRect.Max.y); + table->LastOuterHeight = table->OuterRect.GetHeight(); + + // Setup inner scrolling range + // FIXME: This ideally should be done earlier, in BeginTable() SetNextWindowContentSize call, just like writing to inner_window->DC.CursorMaxPos.y, + // but since the later is likely to be impossible to do we'd rather update both axises together. + if (table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollX) + { + const float outer_padding_for_border = (table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_BordersOuterV) ? TABLE_BORDER_SIZE : 0.0f; + float max_pos_x = table->InnerWindow->DC.CursorMaxPos.x; + if (table->RightMostEnabledColumn != -1) + max_pos_x = ImMax(max_pos_x, table->Columns[table->RightMostEnabledColumn].WorkMaxX + table->CellPaddingX + table->OuterPaddingX - outer_padding_for_border); + if (table->ResizedColumn != -1) + max_pos_x = ImMax(max_pos_x, table->ResizeLockMinContentsX2); + table->InnerWindow->DC.CursorMaxPos.x = max_pos_x; + } + + // Pop clipping rect + if (!(flags & ImGuiTableFlags_NoClip)) + inner_window->DrawList->PopClipRect(); + inner_window->ClipRect = inner_window->DrawList->_ClipRectStack.back(); + + // Draw borders + if ((flags & ImGuiTableFlags_Borders) != 0) + TableDrawBorders(table); + +#if 0 + // Strip out dummy channel draw calls + // We have no way to prevent user submitting direct ImDrawList calls into a hidden column (but ImGui:: calls will be clipped out) + // Pros: remove draw calls which will have no effect. since they'll have zero-size cliprect they may be early out anyway. + // Cons: making it harder for users watching metrics/debugger to spot the wasted vertices. + if (table->DummyDrawChannel != (ImGuiTableColumnIdx)-1) + { + ImDrawChannel* dummy_channel = &table->DrawSplitter._Channels[table->DummyDrawChannel]; + dummy_channel->_CmdBuffer.resize(0); + dummy_channel->_IdxBuffer.resize(0); + } +#endif + + // Flatten channels and merge draw calls + ImDrawListSplitter* splitter = table->DrawSplitter; + splitter->SetCurrentChannel(inner_window->DrawList, 0); + if ((table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_NoClip) == 0) + TableMergeDrawChannels(table); + splitter->Merge(inner_window->DrawList); + + // Update ColumnsAutoFitWidth to get us ahead for host using our size to auto-resize without waiting for next BeginTable() + const float width_spacings = (table->OuterPaddingX * 2.0f) + (table->CellSpacingX1 + table->CellSpacingX2) * (table->ColumnsEnabledCount - 1); + table->ColumnsAutoFitWidth = width_spacings + (table->CellPaddingX * 2.0f) * table->ColumnsEnabledCount; + for (int column_n = 0; column_n < table->ColumnsCount; column_n++) + if (table->EnabledMaskByIndex & ((ImU64)1 << column_n)) + { + ImGuiTableColumn* column = &table->Columns[column_n]; + if ((column->Flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthFixed) && !(column->Flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoResize)) + table->ColumnsAutoFitWidth += column->WidthRequest; + else + table->ColumnsAutoFitWidth += TableGetColumnWidthAuto(table, column); + } + + // Update scroll + if ((table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollX) == 0 && inner_window != outer_window) + { + inner_window->Scroll.x = 0.0f; + } + else if (table->LastResizedColumn != -1 && table->ResizedColumn == -1 && inner_window->ScrollbarX && table->InstanceInteracted == table->InstanceCurrent) + { + // When releasing a column being resized, scroll to keep the resulting column in sight + const float neighbor_width_to_keep_visible = table->MinColumnWidth + table->CellPaddingX * 2.0f; + ImGuiTableColumn* column = &table->Columns[table->LastResizedColumn]; + if (column->MaxX < table->InnerClipRect.Min.x) + SetScrollFromPosX(inner_window, column->MaxX - inner_window->Pos.x - neighbor_width_to_keep_visible, 1.0f); + else if (column->MaxX > table->InnerClipRect.Max.x) + SetScrollFromPosX(inner_window, column->MaxX - inner_window->Pos.x + neighbor_width_to_keep_visible, 1.0f); + } + + // Apply resizing/dragging at the end of the frame + if (table->ResizedColumn != -1 && table->InstanceCurrent == table->InstanceInteracted) + { + ImGuiTableColumn* column = &table->Columns[table->ResizedColumn]; + const float new_x2 = (g.IO.MousePos.x - g.ActiveIdClickOffset.x + TABLE_RESIZE_SEPARATOR_HALF_THICKNESS); + const float new_width = ImFloor(new_x2 - column->MinX - table->CellSpacingX1 - table->CellPaddingX * 2.0f); + table->ResizedColumnNextWidth = new_width; + } + + // Pop from id stack + IM_ASSERT_USER_ERROR(inner_window->IDStack.back() == table->ID + table->InstanceCurrent, "Mismatching PushID/PopID!"); + IM_ASSERT_USER_ERROR(outer_window->DC.ItemWidthStack.Size >= temp_data->HostBackupItemWidthStackSize, "Too many PopItemWidth!"); + PopID(); + + // Restore window data that we modified + const ImVec2 backup_outer_max_pos = outer_window->DC.CursorMaxPos; + inner_window->WorkRect = temp_data->HostBackupWorkRect; + inner_window->ParentWorkRect = temp_data->HostBackupParentWorkRect; + inner_window->SkipItems = table->HostSkipItems; + outer_window->DC.CursorPos = table->OuterRect.Min; + outer_window->DC.ItemWidth = temp_data->HostBackupItemWidth; + outer_window->DC.ItemWidthStack.Size = temp_data->HostBackupItemWidthStackSize; + outer_window->DC.ColumnsOffset = temp_data->HostBackupColumnsOffset; + + // Layout in outer window + // (FIXME: To allow auto-fit and allow desirable effect of SameLine() we dissociate 'used' vs 'ideal' size by overriding + // CursorPosPrevLine and CursorMaxPos manually. That should be a more general layout feature, see same problem e.g. #3414) + if (inner_window != outer_window) + { + EndChild(); + } + else + { + ItemSize(table->OuterRect.GetSize()); + ItemAdd(table->OuterRect, 0); + } + + // Override declared contents width/height to enable auto-resize while not needlessly adding a scrollbar + if (table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_NoHostExtendX) + { + // FIXME-TABLE: Could we remove this section? + // ColumnsAutoFitWidth may be one frame ahead here since for Fixed+NoResize is calculated from latest contents + IM_ASSERT((table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollX) == 0); + outer_window->DC.CursorMaxPos.x = ImMax(backup_outer_max_pos.x, table->OuterRect.Min.x + table->ColumnsAutoFitWidth); + } + else if (temp_data->UserOuterSize.x <= 0.0f) + { + const float decoration_size = (table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollX) ? inner_window->ScrollbarSizes.x : 0.0f; + outer_window->DC.IdealMaxPos.x = ImMax(outer_window->DC.IdealMaxPos.x, table->OuterRect.Min.x + table->ColumnsAutoFitWidth + decoration_size - temp_data->UserOuterSize.x); + outer_window->DC.CursorMaxPos.x = ImMax(backup_outer_max_pos.x, ImMin(table->OuterRect.Max.x, table->OuterRect.Min.x + table->ColumnsAutoFitWidth)); + } + else + { + outer_window->DC.CursorMaxPos.x = ImMax(backup_outer_max_pos.x, table->OuterRect.Max.x); + } + if (temp_data->UserOuterSize.y <= 0.0f) + { + const float decoration_size = (table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollY) ? inner_window->ScrollbarSizes.y : 0.0f; + outer_window->DC.IdealMaxPos.y = ImMax(outer_window->DC.IdealMaxPos.y, inner_content_max_y + decoration_size - temp_data->UserOuterSize.y); + outer_window->DC.CursorMaxPos.y = ImMax(backup_outer_max_pos.y, ImMin(table->OuterRect.Max.y, inner_content_max_y)); + } + else + { + // OuterRect.Max.y may already have been pushed downward from the initial value (unless ImGuiTableFlags_NoHostExtendY is set) + outer_window->DC.CursorMaxPos.y = ImMax(backup_outer_max_pos.y, table->OuterRect.Max.y); + } + + // Save settings + if (table->IsSettingsDirty) + TableSaveSettings(table); + table->IsInitializing = false; + + // Clear or restore current table, if any + IM_ASSERT(g.CurrentWindow == outer_window && g.CurrentTable == table); + IM_ASSERT(g.CurrentTableStackIdx >= 0); + g.CurrentTableStackIdx--; + temp_data = g.CurrentTableStackIdx >= 0 ? &g.TablesTempDataStack[g.CurrentTableStackIdx] : NULL; + g.CurrentTable = temp_data ? g.Tables.GetByIndex(temp_data->TableIndex) : NULL; + if (g.CurrentTable) + { + g.CurrentTable->TempData = temp_data; + g.CurrentTable->DrawSplitter = &temp_data->DrawSplitter; + } + outer_window->DC.CurrentTableIdx = g.CurrentTable ? g.Tables.GetIndex(g.CurrentTable) : -1; +} + +// See "COLUMN SIZING POLICIES" comments at the top of this file +// If (init_width_or_weight <= 0.0f) it is ignored +void ImGui::TableSetupColumn(const char* label, ImGuiTableColumnFlags flags, float init_width_or_weight, ImGuiID user_id) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiTable* table = g.CurrentTable; + IM_ASSERT(table != NULL && "Need to call TableSetupColumn() after BeginTable()!"); + IM_ASSERT(table->IsLayoutLocked == false && "Need to call call TableSetupColumn() before first row!"); + IM_ASSERT((flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_StatusMask_) == 0 && "Illegal to pass StatusMask values to TableSetupColumn()"); + if (table->DeclColumnsCount >= table->ColumnsCount) + { + IM_ASSERT_USER_ERROR(table->DeclColumnsCount < table->ColumnsCount, "Called TableSetupColumn() too many times!"); + return; + } + + ImGuiTableColumn* column = &table->Columns[table->DeclColumnsCount]; + table->DeclColumnsCount++; + + // Assert when passing a width or weight if policy is entirely left to default, to avoid storing width into weight and vice-versa. + // Give a grace to users of ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollX. + if (table->IsDefaultSizingPolicy && (flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthMask_) == 0 && (flags & ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollX) == 0) + IM_ASSERT(init_width_or_weight <= 0.0f && "Can only specify width/weight if sizing policy is set explicitly in either Table or Column."); + + // When passing a width automatically enforce WidthFixed policy + // (whereas TableSetupColumnFlags would default to WidthAuto if table is not Resizable) + if ((flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthMask_) == 0 && init_width_or_weight > 0.0f) + if ((table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_SizingMask_) == ImGuiTableFlags_SizingFixedFit || (table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_SizingMask_) == ImGuiTableFlags_SizingFixedSame) + flags |= ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthFixed; + + TableSetupColumnFlags(table, column, flags); + column->UserID = user_id; + flags = column->Flags; + + // Initialize defaults + column->InitStretchWeightOrWidth = init_width_or_weight; + if (table->IsInitializing) + { + // Init width or weight + if (column->WidthRequest < 0.0f && column->StretchWeight < 0.0f) + { + if ((flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthFixed) && init_width_or_weight > 0.0f) + column->WidthRequest = init_width_or_weight; + if (flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthStretch) + column->StretchWeight = (init_width_or_weight > 0.0f) ? init_width_or_weight : -1.0f; + + // Disable auto-fit if an explicit width/weight has been specified + if (init_width_or_weight > 0.0f) + column->AutoFitQueue = 0x00; + } + + // Init default visibility/sort state + if ((flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_DefaultHide) && (table->SettingsLoadedFlags & ImGuiTableFlags_Hideable) == 0) + column->IsUserEnabled = column->IsUserEnabledNextFrame = false; + if (flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_DefaultSort && (table->SettingsLoadedFlags & ImGuiTableFlags_Sortable) == 0) + { + column->SortOrder = 0; // Multiple columns using _DefaultSort will be reassigned unique SortOrder values when building the sort specs. + column->SortDirection = (column->Flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_PreferSortDescending) ? (ImS8)ImGuiSortDirection_Descending : (ImU8)(ImGuiSortDirection_Ascending); + } + } + + // Store name (append with zero-terminator in contiguous buffer) + column->NameOffset = -1; + if (label != NULL && label[0] != 0) + { + column->NameOffset = (ImS16)table->ColumnsNames.size(); + table->ColumnsNames.append(label, label + strlen(label) + 1); + } +} + +// [Public] +void ImGui::TableSetupScrollFreeze(int columns, int rows) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiTable* table = g.CurrentTable; + IM_ASSERT(table != NULL && "Need to call TableSetupColumn() after BeginTable()!"); + IM_ASSERT(table->IsLayoutLocked == false && "Need to call TableSetupColumn() before first row!"); + IM_ASSERT(columns >= 0 && columns < IMGUI_TABLE_MAX_COLUMNS); + IM_ASSERT(rows >= 0 && rows < 128); // Arbitrary limit + + table->FreezeColumnsRequest = (table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollX) ? (ImGuiTableColumnIdx)ImMin(columns, table->ColumnsCount) : 0; + table->FreezeColumnsCount = (table->InnerWindow->Scroll.x != 0.0f) ? table->FreezeColumnsRequest : 0; + table->FreezeRowsRequest = (table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollY) ? (ImGuiTableColumnIdx)rows : 0; + table->FreezeRowsCount = (table->InnerWindow->Scroll.y != 0.0f) ? table->FreezeRowsRequest : 0; + table->IsUnfrozenRows = (table->FreezeRowsCount == 0); // Make sure this is set before TableUpdateLayout() so ImGuiListClipper can benefit from it.b + + // Ensure frozen columns are ordered in their section. We still allow multiple frozen columns to be reordered. + for (int column_n = 0; column_n < table->FreezeColumnsRequest; column_n++) + { + int order_n = table->DisplayOrderToIndex[column_n]; + if (order_n != column_n && order_n >= table->FreezeColumnsRequest) + { + ImSwap(table->Columns[table->DisplayOrderToIndex[order_n]].DisplayOrder, table->Columns[table->DisplayOrderToIndex[column_n]].DisplayOrder); + ImSwap(table->DisplayOrderToIndex[order_n], table->DisplayOrderToIndex[column_n]); + } + } +} + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Tables: Simple accessors +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// - TableGetColumnCount() +// - TableGetColumnName() +// - TableGetColumnName() [Internal] +// - TableSetColumnEnabled() +// - TableGetColumnFlags() +// - TableGetCellBgRect() [Internal] +// - TableGetColumnResizeID() [Internal] +// - TableGetHoveredColumn() [Internal] +// - TableSetBgColor() +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +int ImGui::TableGetColumnCount() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiTable* table = g.CurrentTable; + return table ? table->ColumnsCount : 0; +} + +const char* ImGui::TableGetColumnName(int column_n) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiTable* table = g.CurrentTable; + if (!table) + return NULL; + if (column_n < 0) + column_n = table->CurrentColumn; + return TableGetColumnName(table, column_n); +} + +const char* ImGui::TableGetColumnName(const ImGuiTable* table, int column_n) +{ + if (table->IsLayoutLocked == false && column_n >= table->DeclColumnsCount) + return ""; // NameOffset is invalid at this point + const ImGuiTableColumn* column = &table->Columns[column_n]; + if (column->NameOffset == -1) + return ""; + return &table->ColumnsNames.Buf[column->NameOffset]; +} + +// Change user accessible enabled/disabled state of a column (often perceived as "showing/hiding" from users point of view) +// Note that end-user can use the context menu to change this themselves (right-click in headers, or right-click in columns body with ImGuiTableFlags_ContextMenuInBody) +// - Require table to have the ImGuiTableFlags_Hideable flag because we are manipulating user accessible state. +// - Request will be applied during next layout, which happens on the first call to TableNextRow() after BeginTable(). +// - For the getter you can test (TableGetColumnFlags() & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_IsEnabled) != 0. +// - Alternative: the ImGuiTableColumnFlags_Disabled is an overriding/master disable flag which will also hide the column from context menu. +void ImGui::TableSetColumnEnabled(int column_n, bool enabled) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiTable* table = g.CurrentTable; + IM_ASSERT(table != NULL); + if (!table) + return; + IM_ASSERT(table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_Hideable); // See comments above + if (column_n < 0) + column_n = table->CurrentColumn; + IM_ASSERT(column_n >= 0 && column_n < table->ColumnsCount); + ImGuiTableColumn* column = &table->Columns[column_n]; + column->IsUserEnabledNextFrame = enabled; +} + +// We allow querying for an extra column in order to poll the IsHovered state of the right-most section +ImGuiTableColumnFlags ImGui::TableGetColumnFlags(int column_n) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiTable* table = g.CurrentTable; + if (!table) + return ImGuiTableColumnFlags_None; + if (column_n < 0) + column_n = table->CurrentColumn; + if (column_n == table->ColumnsCount) + return (table->HoveredColumnBody == column_n) ? ImGuiTableColumnFlags_IsHovered : ImGuiTableColumnFlags_None; + return table->Columns[column_n].Flags; +} + +// Return the cell rectangle based on currently known height. +// - Important: we generally don't know our row height until the end of the row, so Max.y will be incorrect in many situations. +// The only case where this is correct is if we provided a min_row_height to TableNextRow() and don't go below it. +// - Important: if ImGuiTableFlags_PadOuterX is set but ImGuiTableFlags_PadInnerX is not set, the outer-most left and right +// columns report a small offset so their CellBgRect can extend up to the outer border. +ImRect ImGui::TableGetCellBgRect(const ImGuiTable* table, int column_n) +{ + const ImGuiTableColumn* column = &table->Columns[column_n]; + float x1 = column->MinX; + float x2 = column->MaxX; + if (column->PrevEnabledColumn == -1) + x1 -= table->CellSpacingX1; + if (column->NextEnabledColumn == -1) + x2 += table->CellSpacingX2; + return ImRect(x1, table->RowPosY1, x2, table->RowPosY2); +} + +// Return the resizing ID for the right-side of the given column. +ImGuiID ImGui::TableGetColumnResizeID(const ImGuiTable* table, int column_n, int instance_no) +{ + IM_ASSERT(column_n >= 0 && column_n < table->ColumnsCount); + ImGuiID id = table->ID + 1 + (instance_no * table->ColumnsCount) + column_n; + return id; +} + +// Return -1 when table is not hovered. return columns_count if the unused space at the right of visible columns is hovered. +int ImGui::TableGetHoveredColumn() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiTable* table = g.CurrentTable; + if (!table) + return -1; + return (int)table->HoveredColumnBody; +} + +void ImGui::TableSetBgColor(ImGuiTableBgTarget target, ImU32 color, int column_n) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiTable* table = g.CurrentTable; + IM_ASSERT(target != ImGuiTableBgTarget_None); + + if (color == IM_COL32_DISABLE) + color = 0; + + // We cannot draw neither the cell or row background immediately as we don't know the row height at this point in time. + switch (target) + { + case ImGuiTableBgTarget_CellBg: + { + if (table->RowPosY1 > table->InnerClipRect.Max.y) // Discard + return; + if (column_n == -1) + column_n = table->CurrentColumn; + if ((table->VisibleMaskByIndex & ((ImU64)1 << column_n)) == 0) + return; + if (table->RowCellDataCurrent < 0 || table->RowCellData[table->RowCellDataCurrent].Column != column_n) + table->RowCellDataCurrent++; + ImGuiTableCellData* cell_data = &table->RowCellData[table->RowCellDataCurrent]; + cell_data->BgColor = color; + cell_data->Column = (ImGuiTableColumnIdx)column_n; + break; + } + case ImGuiTableBgTarget_RowBg0: + case ImGuiTableBgTarget_RowBg1: + { + if (table->RowPosY1 > table->InnerClipRect.Max.y) // Discard + return; + IM_ASSERT(column_n == -1); + int bg_idx = (target == ImGuiTableBgTarget_RowBg1) ? 1 : 0; + table->RowBgColor[bg_idx] = color; + break; + } + default: + IM_ASSERT(0); + } +} + +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Tables: Row changes +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// - TableGetRowIndex() +// - TableNextRow() +// - TableBeginRow() [Internal] +// - TableEndRow() [Internal] +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// [Public] Note: for row coloring we use ->RowBgColorCounter which is the same value without counting header rows +int ImGui::TableGetRowIndex() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiTable* table = g.CurrentTable; + if (!table) + return 0; + return table->CurrentRow; +} + +// [Public] Starts into the first cell of a new row +void ImGui::TableNextRow(ImGuiTableRowFlags row_flags, float row_min_height) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiTable* table = g.CurrentTable; + + if (!table->IsLayoutLocked) + TableUpdateLayout(table); + if (table->IsInsideRow) + TableEndRow(table); + + table->LastRowFlags = table->RowFlags; + table->RowFlags = row_flags; + table->RowMinHeight = row_min_height; + TableBeginRow(table); + + // We honor min_row_height requested by user, but cannot guarantee per-row maximum height, + // because that would essentially require a unique clipping rectangle per-cell. + table->RowPosY2 += table->CellPaddingY * 2.0f; + table->RowPosY2 = ImMax(table->RowPosY2, table->RowPosY1 + row_min_height); + + // Disable output until user calls TableNextColumn() + table->InnerWindow->SkipItems = true; +} + +// [Internal] Called by TableNextRow() +void ImGui::TableBeginRow(ImGuiTable* table) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = table->InnerWindow; + IM_ASSERT(!table->IsInsideRow); + + // New row + table->CurrentRow++; + table->CurrentColumn = -1; + table->RowBgColor[0] = table->RowBgColor[1] = IM_COL32_DISABLE; + table->RowCellDataCurrent = -1; + table->IsInsideRow = true; + + // Begin frozen rows + float next_y1 = table->RowPosY2; + if (table->CurrentRow == 0 && table->FreezeRowsCount > 0) + next_y1 = window->DC.CursorPos.y = table->OuterRect.Min.y; + + table->RowPosY1 = table->RowPosY2 = next_y1; + table->RowTextBaseline = 0.0f; + table->RowIndentOffsetX = window->DC.Indent.x - table->HostIndentX; // Lock indent + window->DC.PrevLineTextBaseOffset = 0.0f; + window->DC.CursorMaxPos.y = next_y1; + + // Making the header BG color non-transparent will allow us to overlay it multiple times when handling smooth dragging. + if (table->RowFlags & ImGuiTableRowFlags_Headers) + { + TableSetBgColor(ImGuiTableBgTarget_RowBg0, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_TableHeaderBg)); + if (table->CurrentRow == 0) + table->IsUsingHeaders = true; + } +} + +// [Internal] Called by TableNextRow() +void ImGui::TableEndRow(ImGuiTable* table) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + IM_ASSERT(window == table->InnerWindow); + IM_ASSERT(table->IsInsideRow); + + if (table->CurrentColumn != -1) + TableEndCell(table); + + // Logging + if (g.LogEnabled) + LogRenderedText(NULL, "|"); + + // Position cursor at the bottom of our row so it can be used for e.g. clipping calculation. However it is + // likely that the next call to TableBeginCell() will reposition the cursor to take account of vertical padding. + window->DC.CursorPos.y = table->RowPosY2; + + // Row background fill + const float bg_y1 = table->RowPosY1; + const float bg_y2 = table->RowPosY2; + const bool unfreeze_rows_actual = (table->CurrentRow + 1 == table->FreezeRowsCount); + const bool unfreeze_rows_request = (table->CurrentRow + 1 == table->FreezeRowsRequest); + if (table->CurrentRow == 0) + table->LastFirstRowHeight = bg_y2 - bg_y1; + + const bool is_visible = (bg_y2 >= table->InnerClipRect.Min.y && bg_y1 <= table->InnerClipRect.Max.y); + if (is_visible) + { + // Decide of background color for the row + ImU32 bg_col0 = 0; + ImU32 bg_col1 = 0; + if (table->RowBgColor[0] != IM_COL32_DISABLE) + bg_col0 = table->RowBgColor[0]; + else if (table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_RowBg) + bg_col0 = GetColorU32((table->RowBgColorCounter & 1) ? ImGuiCol_TableRowBgAlt : ImGuiCol_TableRowBg); + if (table->RowBgColor[1] != IM_COL32_DISABLE) + bg_col1 = table->RowBgColor[1]; + + // Decide of top border color + ImU32 border_col = 0; + const float border_size = TABLE_BORDER_SIZE; + if (table->CurrentRow > 0 || table->InnerWindow == table->OuterWindow) + if (table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_BordersInnerH) + border_col = (table->LastRowFlags & ImGuiTableRowFlags_Headers) ? table->BorderColorStrong : table->BorderColorLight; + + const bool draw_cell_bg_color = table->RowCellDataCurrent >= 0; + const bool draw_strong_bottom_border = unfreeze_rows_actual; + if ((bg_col0 | bg_col1 | border_col) != 0 || draw_strong_bottom_border || draw_cell_bg_color) + { + // In theory we could call SetWindowClipRectBeforeSetChannel() but since we know TableEndRow() is + // always followed by a change of clipping rectangle we perform the smallest overwrite possible here. + if ((table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_NoClip) == 0) + window->DrawList->_CmdHeader.ClipRect = table->Bg0ClipRectForDrawCmd.ToVec4(); + table->DrawSplitter->SetCurrentChannel(window->DrawList, TABLE_DRAW_CHANNEL_BG0); + } + + // Draw row background + // We soft/cpu clip this so all backgrounds and borders can share the same clipping rectangle + if (bg_col0 || bg_col1) + { + ImRect row_rect(table->WorkRect.Min.x, bg_y1, table->WorkRect.Max.x, bg_y2); + row_rect.ClipWith(table->BgClipRect); + if (bg_col0 != 0 && row_rect.Min.y < row_rect.Max.y) + window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(row_rect.Min, row_rect.Max, bg_col0); + if (bg_col1 != 0 && row_rect.Min.y < row_rect.Max.y) + window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(row_rect.Min, row_rect.Max, bg_col1); + } + + // Draw cell background color + if (draw_cell_bg_color) + { + ImGuiTableCellData* cell_data_end = &table->RowCellData[table->RowCellDataCurrent]; + for (ImGuiTableCellData* cell_data = &table->RowCellData[0]; cell_data <= cell_data_end; cell_data++) + { + const ImGuiTableColumn* column = &table->Columns[cell_data->Column]; + ImRect cell_bg_rect = TableGetCellBgRect(table, cell_data->Column); + cell_bg_rect.ClipWith(table->BgClipRect); + cell_bg_rect.Min.x = ImMax(cell_bg_rect.Min.x, column->ClipRect.Min.x); // So that first column after frozen one gets clipped + cell_bg_rect.Max.x = ImMin(cell_bg_rect.Max.x, column->MaxX); + window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(cell_bg_rect.Min, cell_bg_rect.Max, cell_data->BgColor); + } + } + + // Draw top border + if (border_col && bg_y1 >= table->BgClipRect.Min.y && bg_y1 < table->BgClipRect.Max.y) + window->DrawList->AddLine(ImVec2(table->BorderX1, bg_y1), ImVec2(table->BorderX2, bg_y1), border_col, border_size); + + // Draw bottom border at the row unfreezing mark (always strong) + if (draw_strong_bottom_border && bg_y2 >= table->BgClipRect.Min.y && bg_y2 < table->BgClipRect.Max.y) + window->DrawList->AddLine(ImVec2(table->BorderX1, bg_y2), ImVec2(table->BorderX2, bg_y2), table->BorderColorStrong, border_size); + } + + // End frozen rows (when we are past the last frozen row line, teleport cursor and alter clipping rectangle) + // We need to do that in TableEndRow() instead of TableBeginRow() so the list clipper can mark end of row and + // get the new cursor position. + if (unfreeze_rows_request) + for (int column_n = 0; column_n < table->ColumnsCount; column_n++) + { + ImGuiTableColumn* column = &table->Columns[column_n]; + column->NavLayerCurrent = (ImS8)((column_n < table->FreezeColumnsCount) ? ImGuiNavLayer_Menu : ImGuiNavLayer_Main); + } + if (unfreeze_rows_actual) + { + IM_ASSERT(table->IsUnfrozenRows == false); + table->IsUnfrozenRows = true; + + // BgClipRect starts as table->InnerClipRect, reduce it now and make BgClipRectForDrawCmd == BgClipRect + float y0 = ImMax(table->RowPosY2 + 1, window->InnerClipRect.Min.y); + table->BgClipRect.Min.y = table->Bg2ClipRectForDrawCmd.Min.y = ImMin(y0, window->InnerClipRect.Max.y); + table->BgClipRect.Max.y = table->Bg2ClipRectForDrawCmd.Max.y = window->InnerClipRect.Max.y; + table->Bg2DrawChannelCurrent = table->Bg2DrawChannelUnfrozen; + IM_ASSERT(table->Bg2ClipRectForDrawCmd.Min.y <= table->Bg2ClipRectForDrawCmd.Max.y); + + float row_height = table->RowPosY2 - table->RowPosY1; + table->RowPosY2 = window->DC.CursorPos.y = table->WorkRect.Min.y + table->RowPosY2 - table->OuterRect.Min.y; + table->RowPosY1 = table->RowPosY2 - row_height; + for (int column_n = 0; column_n < table->ColumnsCount; column_n++) + { + ImGuiTableColumn* column = &table->Columns[column_n]; + column->DrawChannelCurrent = column->DrawChannelUnfrozen; + column->ClipRect.Min.y = table->Bg2ClipRectForDrawCmd.Min.y; + } + + // Update cliprect ahead of TableBeginCell() so clipper can access to new ClipRect->Min.y + SetWindowClipRectBeforeSetChannel(window, table->Columns[0].ClipRect); + table->DrawSplitter->SetCurrentChannel(window->DrawList, table->Columns[0].DrawChannelCurrent); + } + + if (!(table->RowFlags & ImGuiTableRowFlags_Headers)) + table->RowBgColorCounter++; + table->IsInsideRow = false; +} + +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Tables: Columns changes +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// - TableGetColumnIndex() +// - TableSetColumnIndex() +// - TableNextColumn() +// - TableBeginCell() [Internal] +// - TableEndCell() [Internal] +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +int ImGui::TableGetColumnIndex() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiTable* table = g.CurrentTable; + if (!table) + return 0; + return table->CurrentColumn; +} + +// [Public] Append into a specific column +bool ImGui::TableSetColumnIndex(int column_n) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiTable* table = g.CurrentTable; + if (!table) + return false; + + if (table->CurrentColumn != column_n) + { + if (table->CurrentColumn != -1) + TableEndCell(table); + IM_ASSERT(column_n >= 0 && table->ColumnsCount); + TableBeginCell(table, column_n); + } + + // Return whether the column is visible. User may choose to skip submitting items based on this return value, + // however they shouldn't skip submitting for columns that may have the tallest contribution to row height. + return (table->RequestOutputMaskByIndex & ((ImU64)1 << column_n)) != 0; +} + +// [Public] Append into the next column, wrap and create a new row when already on last column +bool ImGui::TableNextColumn() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiTable* table = g.CurrentTable; + if (!table) + return false; + + if (table->IsInsideRow && table->CurrentColumn + 1 < table->ColumnsCount) + { + if (table->CurrentColumn != -1) + TableEndCell(table); + TableBeginCell(table, table->CurrentColumn + 1); + } + else + { + TableNextRow(); + TableBeginCell(table, 0); + } + + // Return whether the column is visible. User may choose to skip submitting items based on this return value, + // however they shouldn't skip submitting for columns that may have the tallest contribution to row height. + int column_n = table->CurrentColumn; + return (table->RequestOutputMaskByIndex & ((ImU64)1 << column_n)) != 0; +} + + +// [Internal] Called by TableSetColumnIndex()/TableNextColumn() +// This is called very frequently, so we need to be mindful of unnecessary overhead. +// FIXME-TABLE FIXME-OPT: Could probably shortcut some things for non-active or clipped columns. +void ImGui::TableBeginCell(ImGuiTable* table, int column_n) +{ + ImGuiTableColumn* column = &table->Columns[column_n]; + ImGuiWindow* window = table->InnerWindow; + table->CurrentColumn = column_n; + + // Start position is roughly ~~ CellRect.Min + CellPadding + Indent + float start_x = column->WorkMinX; + if (column->Flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_IndentEnable) + start_x += table->RowIndentOffsetX; // ~~ += window.DC.Indent.x - table->HostIndentX, except we locked it for the row. + + window->DC.CursorPos.x = start_x; + window->DC.CursorPos.y = table->RowPosY1 + table->CellPaddingY; + window->DC.CursorMaxPos.x = window->DC.CursorPos.x; + window->DC.ColumnsOffset.x = start_x - window->Pos.x - window->DC.Indent.x; // FIXME-WORKRECT + window->DC.CurrLineTextBaseOffset = table->RowTextBaseline; + window->DC.NavLayerCurrent = (ImGuiNavLayer)column->NavLayerCurrent; + + window->WorkRect.Min.y = window->DC.CursorPos.y; + window->WorkRect.Min.x = column->WorkMinX; + window->WorkRect.Max.x = column->WorkMaxX; + window->DC.ItemWidth = column->ItemWidth; + + // To allow ImGuiListClipper to function we propagate our row height + if (!column->IsEnabled) + window->DC.CursorPos.y = ImMax(window->DC.CursorPos.y, table->RowPosY2); + + window->SkipItems = column->IsSkipItems; + if (column->IsSkipItems) + { + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + g.LastItemData.ID = 0; + g.LastItemData.StatusFlags = 0; + } + + if (table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_NoClip) + { + // FIXME: if we end up drawing all borders/bg in EndTable, could remove this and just assert that channel hasn't changed. + table->DrawSplitter->SetCurrentChannel(window->DrawList, TABLE_DRAW_CHANNEL_NOCLIP); + //IM_ASSERT(table->DrawSplitter._Current == TABLE_DRAW_CHANNEL_NOCLIP); + } + else + { + // FIXME-TABLE: Could avoid this if draw channel is dummy channel? + SetWindowClipRectBeforeSetChannel(window, column->ClipRect); + table->DrawSplitter->SetCurrentChannel(window->DrawList, column->DrawChannelCurrent); + } + + // Logging + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + if (g.LogEnabled && !column->IsSkipItems) + { + LogRenderedText(&window->DC.CursorPos, "|"); + g.LogLinePosY = FLT_MAX; + } +} + +// [Internal] Called by TableNextRow()/TableSetColumnIndex()/TableNextColumn() +void ImGui::TableEndCell(ImGuiTable* table) +{ + ImGuiTableColumn* column = &table->Columns[table->CurrentColumn]; + ImGuiWindow* window = table->InnerWindow; + + // Report maximum position so we can infer content size per column. + float* p_max_pos_x; + if (table->RowFlags & ImGuiTableRowFlags_Headers) + p_max_pos_x = &column->ContentMaxXHeadersUsed; // Useful in case user submit contents in header row that is not a TableHeader() call + else + p_max_pos_x = table->IsUnfrozenRows ? &column->ContentMaxXUnfrozen : &column->ContentMaxXFrozen; + *p_max_pos_x = ImMax(*p_max_pos_x, window->DC.CursorMaxPos.x); + table->RowPosY2 = ImMax(table->RowPosY2, window->DC.CursorMaxPos.y + table->CellPaddingY); + column->ItemWidth = window->DC.ItemWidth; + + // Propagate text baseline for the entire row + // FIXME-TABLE: Here we propagate text baseline from the last line of the cell.. instead of the first one. + table->RowTextBaseline = ImMax(table->RowTextBaseline, window->DC.PrevLineTextBaseOffset); +} + +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Tables: Columns width management +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// - TableGetMaxColumnWidth() [Internal] +// - TableGetColumnWidthAuto() [Internal] +// - TableSetColumnWidth() +// - TableSetColumnWidthAutoSingle() [Internal] +// - TableSetColumnWidthAutoAll() [Internal] +// - TableUpdateColumnsWeightFromWidth() [Internal] +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// Maximum column content width given current layout. Use column->MinX so this value on a per-column basis. +float ImGui::TableGetMaxColumnWidth(const ImGuiTable* table, int column_n) +{ + const ImGuiTableColumn* column = &table->Columns[column_n]; + float max_width = FLT_MAX; + const float min_column_distance = table->MinColumnWidth + table->CellPaddingX * 2.0f + table->CellSpacingX1 + table->CellSpacingX2; + if (table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollX) + { + // Frozen columns can't reach beyond visible width else scrolling will naturally break. + // (we use DisplayOrder as within a set of multiple frozen column reordering is possible) + if (column->DisplayOrder < table->FreezeColumnsRequest) + { + max_width = (table->InnerClipRect.Max.x - (table->FreezeColumnsRequest - column->DisplayOrder) * min_column_distance) - column->MinX; + max_width = max_width - table->OuterPaddingX - table->CellPaddingX - table->CellSpacingX2; + } + } + else if ((table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_NoKeepColumnsVisible) == 0) + { + // If horizontal scrolling if disabled, we apply a final lossless shrinking of columns in order to make + // sure they are all visible. Because of this we also know that all of the columns will always fit in + // table->WorkRect and therefore in table->InnerRect (because ScrollX is off) + // FIXME-TABLE: This is solved incorrectly but also quite a difficult problem to fix as we also want ClipRect width to match. + // See "table_width_distrib" and "table_width_keep_visible" tests + max_width = table->WorkRect.Max.x - (table->ColumnsEnabledCount - column->IndexWithinEnabledSet - 1) * min_column_distance - column->MinX; + //max_width -= table->CellSpacingX1; + max_width -= table->CellSpacingX2; + max_width -= table->CellPaddingX * 2.0f; + max_width -= table->OuterPaddingX; + } + return max_width; +} + +// Note this is meant to be stored in column->WidthAuto, please generally use the WidthAuto field +float ImGui::TableGetColumnWidthAuto(ImGuiTable* table, ImGuiTableColumn* column) +{ + const float content_width_body = ImMax(column->ContentMaxXFrozen, column->ContentMaxXUnfrozen) - column->WorkMinX; + const float content_width_headers = column->ContentMaxXHeadersIdeal - column->WorkMinX; + float width_auto = content_width_body; + if (!(column->Flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoHeaderWidth)) + width_auto = ImMax(width_auto, content_width_headers); + + // Non-resizable fixed columns preserve their requested width + if ((column->Flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthFixed) && column->InitStretchWeightOrWidth > 0.0f) + if (!(table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_Resizable) || (column->Flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoResize)) + width_auto = column->InitStretchWeightOrWidth; + + return ImMax(width_auto, table->MinColumnWidth); +} + +// 'width' = inner column width, without padding +void ImGui::TableSetColumnWidth(int column_n, float width) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiTable* table = g.CurrentTable; + IM_ASSERT(table != NULL && table->IsLayoutLocked == false); + IM_ASSERT(column_n >= 0 && column_n < table->ColumnsCount); + ImGuiTableColumn* column_0 = &table->Columns[column_n]; + float column_0_width = width; + + // Apply constraints early + // Compare both requested and actual given width to avoid overwriting requested width when column is stuck (minimum size, bounded) + IM_ASSERT(table->MinColumnWidth > 0.0f); + const float min_width = table->MinColumnWidth; + const float max_width = ImMax(min_width, TableGetMaxColumnWidth(table, column_n)); + column_0_width = ImClamp(column_0_width, min_width, max_width); + if (column_0->WidthGiven == column_0_width || column_0->WidthRequest == column_0_width) + return; + + //IMGUI_DEBUG_LOG("TableSetColumnWidth(%d, %.1f->%.1f)\n", column_0_idx, column_0->WidthGiven, column_0_width); + ImGuiTableColumn* column_1 = (column_0->NextEnabledColumn != -1) ? &table->Columns[column_0->NextEnabledColumn] : NULL; + + // In this surprisingly not simple because of how we support mixing Fixed and multiple Stretch columns. + // - All fixed: easy. + // - All stretch: easy. + // - One or more fixed + one stretch: easy. + // - One or more fixed + more than one stretch: tricky. + // Qt when manual resize is enabled only support a single _trailing_ stretch column. + + // When forwarding resize from Wn| to Fn+1| we need to be considerate of the _NoResize flag on Fn+1. + // FIXME-TABLE: Find a way to rewrite all of this so interactions feel more consistent for the user. + // Scenarios: + // - F1 F2 F3 resize from F1| or F2| --> ok: alter ->WidthRequested of Fixed column. Subsequent columns will be offset. + // - F1 F2 F3 resize from F3| --> ok: alter ->WidthRequested of Fixed column. If active, ScrollX extent can be altered. + // - F1 F2 W3 resize from F1| or F2| --> ok: alter ->WidthRequested of Fixed column. If active, ScrollX extent can be altered, but it doesn't make much sense as the Stretch column will always be minimal size. + // - F1 F2 W3 resize from W3| --> ok: no-op (disabled by Resize Rule 1) + // - W1 W2 W3 resize from W1| or W2| --> ok + // - W1 W2 W3 resize from W3| --> ok: no-op (disabled by Resize Rule 1) + // - W1 F2 F3 resize from F3| --> ok: no-op (disabled by Resize Rule 1) + // - W1 F2 resize from F2| --> ok: no-op (disabled by Resize Rule 1) + // - W1 W2 F3 resize from W1| or W2| --> ok + // - W1 F2 W3 resize from W1| or F2| --> ok + // - F1 W2 F3 resize from W2| --> ok + // - F1 W3 F2 resize from W3| --> ok + // - W1 F2 F3 resize from W1| --> ok: equivalent to resizing |F2. F3 will not move. + // - W1 F2 F3 resize from F2| --> ok + // All resizes from a Wx columns are locking other columns. + + // Possible improvements: + // - W1 W2 W3 resize W1| --> to not be stuck, both W2 and W3 would stretch down. Seems possible to fix. Would be most beneficial to simplify resize of all-weighted columns. + // - W3 F1 F2 resize W3| --> to not be stuck past F1|, both F1 and F2 would need to stretch down, which would be lossy or ambiguous. Seems hard to fix. + + // [Resize Rule 1] Can't resize from right of right-most visible column if there is any Stretch column. Implemented in TableUpdateLayout(). + + // If we have all Fixed columns OR resizing a Fixed column that doesn't come after a Stretch one, we can do an offsetting resize. + // This is the preferred resize path + if (column_0->Flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthFixed) + if (!column_1 || table->LeftMostStretchedColumn == -1 || table->Columns[table->LeftMostStretchedColumn].DisplayOrder >= column_0->DisplayOrder) + { + column_0->WidthRequest = column_0_width; + table->IsSettingsDirty = true; + return; + } + + // We can also use previous column if there's no next one (this is used when doing an auto-fit on the right-most stretch column) + if (column_1 == NULL) + column_1 = (column_0->PrevEnabledColumn != -1) ? &table->Columns[column_0->PrevEnabledColumn] : NULL; + if (column_1 == NULL) + return; + + // Resizing from right-side of a Stretch column before a Fixed column forward sizing to left-side of fixed column. + // (old_a + old_b == new_a + new_b) --> (new_a == old_a + old_b - new_b) + float column_1_width = ImMax(column_1->WidthRequest - (column_0_width - column_0->WidthRequest), min_width); + column_0_width = column_0->WidthRequest + column_1->WidthRequest - column_1_width; + IM_ASSERT(column_0_width > 0.0f && column_1_width > 0.0f); + column_0->WidthRequest = column_0_width; + column_1->WidthRequest = column_1_width; + if ((column_0->Flags | column_1->Flags) & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthStretch) + TableUpdateColumnsWeightFromWidth(table); + table->IsSettingsDirty = true; +} + +// Disable clipping then auto-fit, will take 2 frames +// (we don't take a shortcut for unclipped columns to reduce inconsistencies when e.g. resizing multiple columns) +void ImGui::TableSetColumnWidthAutoSingle(ImGuiTable* table, int column_n) +{ + // Single auto width uses auto-fit + ImGuiTableColumn* column = &table->Columns[column_n]; + if (!column->IsEnabled) + return; + column->CannotSkipItemsQueue = (1 << 0); + table->AutoFitSingleColumn = (ImGuiTableColumnIdx)column_n; +} + +void ImGui::TableSetColumnWidthAutoAll(ImGuiTable* table) +{ + for (int column_n = 0; column_n < table->ColumnsCount; column_n++) + { + ImGuiTableColumn* column = &table->Columns[column_n]; + if (!column->IsEnabled && !(column->Flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthStretch)) // Cannot reset weight of hidden stretch column + continue; + column->CannotSkipItemsQueue = (1 << 0); + column->AutoFitQueue = (1 << 1); + } +} + +void ImGui::TableUpdateColumnsWeightFromWidth(ImGuiTable* table) +{ + IM_ASSERT(table->LeftMostStretchedColumn != -1 && table->RightMostStretchedColumn != -1); + + // Measure existing quantity + float visible_weight = 0.0f; + float visible_width = 0.0f; + for (int column_n = 0; column_n < table->ColumnsCount; column_n++) + { + ImGuiTableColumn* column = &table->Columns[column_n]; + if (!column->IsEnabled || !(column->Flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthStretch)) + continue; + IM_ASSERT(column->StretchWeight > 0.0f); + visible_weight += column->StretchWeight; + visible_width += column->WidthRequest; + } + IM_ASSERT(visible_weight > 0.0f && visible_width > 0.0f); + + // Apply new weights + for (int column_n = 0; column_n < table->ColumnsCount; column_n++) + { + ImGuiTableColumn* column = &table->Columns[column_n]; + if (!column->IsEnabled || !(column->Flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthStretch)) + continue; + column->StretchWeight = (column->WidthRequest / visible_width) * visible_weight; + IM_ASSERT(column->StretchWeight > 0.0f); + } +} + +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Tables: Drawing +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// - TablePushBackgroundChannel() [Internal] +// - TablePopBackgroundChannel() [Internal] +// - TableSetupDrawChannels() [Internal] +// - TableMergeDrawChannels() [Internal] +// - TableDrawBorders() [Internal] +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// Bg2 is used by Selectable (and possibly other widgets) to render to the background. +// Unlike our Bg0/1 channel which we uses for RowBg/CellBg/Borders and where we guarantee all shapes to be CPU-clipped, the Bg2 channel being widgets-facing will rely on regular ClipRect. +void ImGui::TablePushBackgroundChannel() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + ImGuiTable* table = g.CurrentTable; + + // Optimization: avoid SetCurrentChannel() + PushClipRect() + table->HostBackupInnerClipRect = window->ClipRect; + SetWindowClipRectBeforeSetChannel(window, table->Bg2ClipRectForDrawCmd); + table->DrawSplitter->SetCurrentChannel(window->DrawList, table->Bg2DrawChannelCurrent); +} + +void ImGui::TablePopBackgroundChannel() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + ImGuiTable* table = g.CurrentTable; + ImGuiTableColumn* column = &table->Columns[table->CurrentColumn]; + + // Optimization: avoid PopClipRect() + SetCurrentChannel() + SetWindowClipRectBeforeSetChannel(window, table->HostBackupInnerClipRect); + table->DrawSplitter->SetCurrentChannel(window->DrawList, column->DrawChannelCurrent); +} + +// Allocate draw channels. Called by TableUpdateLayout() +// - We allocate them following storage order instead of display order so reordering columns won't needlessly +// increase overall dormant memory cost. +// - We isolate headers draw commands in their own channels instead of just altering clip rects. +// This is in order to facilitate merging of draw commands. +// - After crossing FreezeRowsCount, all columns see their current draw channel changed to a second set of channels. +// - We only use the dummy draw channel so we can push a null clipping rectangle into it without affecting other +// channels, while simplifying per-row/per-cell overhead. It will be empty and discarded when merged. +// - We allocate 1 or 2 background draw channels. This is because we know TablePushBackgroundChannel() is only used for +// horizontal spanning. If we allowed vertical spanning we'd need one background draw channel per merge group (1-4). +// Draw channel allocation (before merging): +// - NoClip --> 2+D+1 channels: bg0/1 + bg2 + foreground (same clip rect == always 1 draw call) +// - Clip --> 2+D+N channels +// - FreezeRows --> 2+D+N*2 (unless scrolling value is zero) +// - FreezeRows || FreezeColunns --> 3+D+N*2 (unless scrolling value is zero) +// Where D is 1 if any column is clipped or hidden (dummy channel) otherwise 0. +void ImGui::TableSetupDrawChannels(ImGuiTable* table) +{ + const int freeze_row_multiplier = (table->FreezeRowsCount > 0) ? 2 : 1; + const int channels_for_row = (table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_NoClip) ? 1 : table->ColumnsEnabledCount; + const int channels_for_bg = 1 + 1 * freeze_row_multiplier; + const int channels_for_dummy = (table->ColumnsEnabledCount < table->ColumnsCount || table->VisibleMaskByIndex != table->EnabledMaskByIndex) ? +1 : 0; + const int channels_total = channels_for_bg + (channels_for_row * freeze_row_multiplier) + channels_for_dummy; + table->DrawSplitter->Split(table->InnerWindow->DrawList, channels_total); + table->DummyDrawChannel = (ImGuiTableDrawChannelIdx)((channels_for_dummy > 0) ? channels_total - 1 : -1); + table->Bg2DrawChannelCurrent = TABLE_DRAW_CHANNEL_BG2_FROZEN; + table->Bg2DrawChannelUnfrozen = (ImGuiTableDrawChannelIdx)((table->FreezeRowsCount > 0) ? 2 + channels_for_row : TABLE_DRAW_CHANNEL_BG2_FROZEN); + + int draw_channel_current = 2; + for (int column_n = 0; column_n < table->ColumnsCount; column_n++) + { + ImGuiTableColumn* column = &table->Columns[column_n]; + if (column->IsVisibleX && column->IsVisibleY) + { + column->DrawChannelFrozen = (ImGuiTableDrawChannelIdx)(draw_channel_current); + column->DrawChannelUnfrozen = (ImGuiTableDrawChannelIdx)(draw_channel_current + (table->FreezeRowsCount > 0 ? channels_for_row + 1 : 0)); + if (!(table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_NoClip)) + draw_channel_current++; + } + else + { + column->DrawChannelFrozen = column->DrawChannelUnfrozen = table->DummyDrawChannel; + } + column->DrawChannelCurrent = column->DrawChannelFrozen; + } + + // Initial draw cmd starts with a BgClipRect that matches the one of its host, to facilitate merge draw commands by default. + // All our cell highlight are manually clipped with BgClipRect. When unfreezing it will be made smaller to fit scrolling rect. + // (This technically isn't part of setting up draw channels, but is reasonably related to be done here) + table->BgClipRect = table->InnerClipRect; + table->Bg0ClipRectForDrawCmd = table->OuterWindow->ClipRect; + table->Bg2ClipRectForDrawCmd = table->HostClipRect; + IM_ASSERT(table->BgClipRect.Min.y <= table->BgClipRect.Max.y); +} + +// This function reorder draw channels based on matching clip rectangle, to facilitate merging them. Called by EndTable(). +// For simplicity we call it TableMergeDrawChannels() but in fact it only reorder channels + overwrite ClipRect, +// actual merging is done by table->DrawSplitter.Merge() which is called right after TableMergeDrawChannels(). +// +// Columns where the contents didn't stray off their local clip rectangle can be merged. To achieve +// this we merge their clip rect and make them contiguous in the channel list, so they can be merged +// by the call to DrawSplitter.Merge() following to the call to this function. +// We reorder draw commands by arranging them into a maximum of 4 distinct groups: +// +// 1 group: 2 groups: 2 groups: 4 groups: +// [ 0. ] no freeze [ 0. ] row freeze [ 01 ] col freeze [ 01 ] row+col freeze +// [ .. ] or no scroll [ 2. ] and v-scroll [ .. ] and h-scroll [ 23 ] and v+h-scroll +// +// Each column itself can use 1 channel (row freeze disabled) or 2 channels (row freeze enabled). +// When the contents of a column didn't stray off its limit, we move its channels into the corresponding group +// based on its position (within frozen rows/columns groups or not). +// At the end of the operation our 1-4 groups will each have a ImDrawCmd using the same ClipRect. +// This function assume that each column are pointing to a distinct draw channel, +// otherwise merge_group->ChannelsCount will not match set bit count of merge_group->ChannelsMask. +// +// Column channels will not be merged into one of the 1-4 groups in the following cases: +// - The contents stray off its clipping rectangle (we only compare the MaxX value, not the MinX value). +// Direct ImDrawList calls won't be taken into account by default, if you use them make sure the ImGui:: bounds +// matches, by e.g. calling SetCursorScreenPos(). +// - The channel uses more than one draw command itself. We drop all our attempt at merging stuff here.. +// we could do better but it's going to be rare and probably not worth the hassle. +// Columns for which the draw channel(s) haven't been merged with other will use their own ImDrawCmd. +// +// This function is particularly tricky to understand.. take a breath. +void ImGui::TableMergeDrawChannels(ImGuiTable* table) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImDrawListSplitter* splitter = table->DrawSplitter; + const bool has_freeze_v = (table->FreezeRowsCount > 0); + const bool has_freeze_h = (table->FreezeColumnsCount > 0); + IM_ASSERT(splitter->_Current == 0); + + // Track which groups we are going to attempt to merge, and which channels goes into each group. + struct MergeGroup + { + ImRect ClipRect; + int ChannelsCount; + ImBitArray ChannelsMask; + + MergeGroup() { ChannelsCount = 0; } + }; + int merge_group_mask = 0x00; + MergeGroup merge_groups[4]; + + // 1. Scan channels and take note of those which can be merged + for (int column_n = 0; column_n < table->ColumnsCount; column_n++) + { + if ((table->VisibleMaskByIndex & ((ImU64)1 << column_n)) == 0) + continue; + ImGuiTableColumn* column = &table->Columns[column_n]; + + const int merge_group_sub_count = has_freeze_v ? 2 : 1; + for (int merge_group_sub_n = 0; merge_group_sub_n < merge_group_sub_count; merge_group_sub_n++) + { + const int channel_no = (merge_group_sub_n == 0) ? column->DrawChannelFrozen : column->DrawChannelUnfrozen; + + // Don't attempt to merge if there are multiple draw calls within the column + ImDrawChannel* src_channel = &splitter->_Channels[channel_no]; + if (src_channel->_CmdBuffer.Size > 0 && src_channel->_CmdBuffer.back().ElemCount == 0) + src_channel->_CmdBuffer.pop_back(); + if (src_channel->_CmdBuffer.Size != 1) + continue; + + // Find out the width of this merge group and check if it will fit in our column + // (note that we assume that rendering didn't stray on the left direction. we should need a CursorMinPos to detect it) + if (!(column->Flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoClip)) + { + float content_max_x; + if (!has_freeze_v) + content_max_x = ImMax(column->ContentMaxXUnfrozen, column->ContentMaxXHeadersUsed); // No row freeze + else if (merge_group_sub_n == 0) + content_max_x = ImMax(column->ContentMaxXFrozen, column->ContentMaxXHeadersUsed); // Row freeze: use width before freeze + else + content_max_x = column->ContentMaxXUnfrozen; // Row freeze: use width after freeze + if (content_max_x > column->ClipRect.Max.x) + continue; + } + + const int merge_group_n = (has_freeze_h && column_n < table->FreezeColumnsCount ? 0 : 1) + (has_freeze_v && merge_group_sub_n == 0 ? 0 : 2); + IM_ASSERT(channel_no < IMGUI_TABLE_MAX_DRAW_CHANNELS); + MergeGroup* merge_group = &merge_groups[merge_group_n]; + if (merge_group->ChannelsCount == 0) + merge_group->ClipRect = ImRect(+FLT_MAX, +FLT_MAX, -FLT_MAX, -FLT_MAX); + merge_group->ChannelsMask.SetBit(channel_no); + merge_group->ChannelsCount++; + merge_group->ClipRect.Add(src_channel->_CmdBuffer[0].ClipRect); + merge_group_mask |= (1 << merge_group_n); + } + + // Invalidate current draw channel + // (we don't clear DrawChannelFrozen/DrawChannelUnfrozen solely to facilitate debugging/later inspection of data) + column->DrawChannelCurrent = (ImGuiTableDrawChannelIdx)-1; + } + + // [DEBUG] Display merge groups +#if 0 + if (g.IO.KeyShift) + for (int merge_group_n = 0; merge_group_n < IM_ARRAYSIZE(merge_groups); merge_group_n++) + { + MergeGroup* merge_group = &merge_groups[merge_group_n]; + if (merge_group->ChannelsCount == 0) + continue; + char buf[32]; + ImFormatString(buf, 32, "MG%d:%d", merge_group_n, merge_group->ChannelsCount); + ImVec2 text_pos = merge_group->ClipRect.Min + ImVec2(4, 4); + ImVec2 text_size = CalcTextSize(buf, NULL); + GetForegroundDrawList()->AddRectFilled(text_pos, text_pos + text_size, IM_COL32(0, 0, 0, 255)); + GetForegroundDrawList()->AddText(text_pos, IM_COL32(255, 255, 0, 255), buf, NULL); + GetForegroundDrawList()->AddRect(merge_group->ClipRect.Min, merge_group->ClipRect.Max, IM_COL32(255, 255, 0, 255)); + } +#endif + + // 2. Rewrite channel list in our preferred order + if (merge_group_mask != 0) + { + // We skip channel 0 (Bg0/Bg1) and 1 (Bg2 frozen) from the shuffling since they won't move - see channels allocation in TableSetupDrawChannels(). + const int LEADING_DRAW_CHANNELS = 2; + g.DrawChannelsTempMergeBuffer.resize(splitter->_Count - LEADING_DRAW_CHANNELS); // Use shared temporary storage so the allocation gets amortized + ImDrawChannel* dst_tmp = g.DrawChannelsTempMergeBuffer.Data; + ImBitArray remaining_mask; // We need 132-bit of storage + remaining_mask.SetBitRange(LEADING_DRAW_CHANNELS, splitter->_Count); + remaining_mask.ClearBit(table->Bg2DrawChannelUnfrozen); + IM_ASSERT(has_freeze_v == false || table->Bg2DrawChannelUnfrozen != TABLE_DRAW_CHANNEL_BG2_FROZEN); + int remaining_count = splitter->_Count - (has_freeze_v ? LEADING_DRAW_CHANNELS + 1 : LEADING_DRAW_CHANNELS); + //ImRect host_rect = (table->InnerWindow == table->OuterWindow) ? table->InnerClipRect : table->HostClipRect; + ImRect host_rect = table->HostClipRect; + for (int merge_group_n = 0; merge_group_n < IM_ARRAYSIZE(merge_groups); merge_group_n++) + { + if (int merge_channels_count = merge_groups[merge_group_n].ChannelsCount) + { + MergeGroup* merge_group = &merge_groups[merge_group_n]; + ImRect merge_clip_rect = merge_group->ClipRect; + + // Extend outer-most clip limits to match those of host, so draw calls can be merged even if + // outer-most columns have some outer padding offsetting them from their parent ClipRect. + // The principal cases this is dealing with are: + // - On a same-window table (not scrolling = single group), all fitting columns ClipRect -> will extend and match host ClipRect -> will merge + // - Columns can use padding and have left-most ClipRect.Min.x and right-most ClipRect.Max.x != from host ClipRect -> will extend and match host ClipRect -> will merge + // FIXME-TABLE FIXME-WORKRECT: We are wasting a merge opportunity on tables without scrolling if column doesn't fit + // within host clip rect, solely because of the half-padding difference between window->WorkRect and window->InnerClipRect. + if ((merge_group_n & 1) == 0 || !has_freeze_h) + merge_clip_rect.Min.x = ImMin(merge_clip_rect.Min.x, host_rect.Min.x); + if ((merge_group_n & 2) == 0 || !has_freeze_v) + merge_clip_rect.Min.y = ImMin(merge_clip_rect.Min.y, host_rect.Min.y); + if ((merge_group_n & 1) != 0) + merge_clip_rect.Max.x = ImMax(merge_clip_rect.Max.x, host_rect.Max.x); + if ((merge_group_n & 2) != 0 && (table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_NoHostExtendY) == 0) + merge_clip_rect.Max.y = ImMax(merge_clip_rect.Max.y, host_rect.Max.y); +#if 0 + GetOverlayDrawList()->AddRect(merge_group->ClipRect.Min, merge_group->ClipRect.Max, IM_COL32(255, 0, 0, 200), 0.0f, 0, 1.0f); + GetOverlayDrawList()->AddLine(merge_group->ClipRect.Min, merge_clip_rect.Min, IM_COL32(255, 100, 0, 200)); + GetOverlayDrawList()->AddLine(merge_group->ClipRect.Max, merge_clip_rect.Max, IM_COL32(255, 100, 0, 200)); +#endif + remaining_count -= merge_group->ChannelsCount; + for (int n = 0; n < IM_ARRAYSIZE(remaining_mask.Storage); n++) + remaining_mask.Storage[n] &= ~merge_group->ChannelsMask.Storage[n]; + for (int n = 0; n < splitter->_Count && merge_channels_count != 0; n++) + { + // Copy + overwrite new clip rect + if (!merge_group->ChannelsMask.TestBit(n)) + continue; + merge_group->ChannelsMask.ClearBit(n); + merge_channels_count--; + + ImDrawChannel* channel = &splitter->_Channels[n]; + IM_ASSERT(channel->_CmdBuffer.Size == 1 && merge_clip_rect.Contains(ImRect(channel->_CmdBuffer[0].ClipRect))); + channel->_CmdBuffer[0].ClipRect = merge_clip_rect.ToVec4(); + memcpy(dst_tmp++, channel, sizeof(ImDrawChannel)); + } + } + + // Make sure Bg2DrawChannelUnfrozen appears in the middle of our groups (whereas Bg0/Bg1 and Bg2 frozen are fixed to 0 and 1) + if (merge_group_n == 1 && has_freeze_v) + memcpy(dst_tmp++, &splitter->_Channels[table->Bg2DrawChannelUnfrozen], sizeof(ImDrawChannel)); + } + + // Append unmergeable channels that we didn't reorder at the end of the list + for (int n = 0; n < splitter->_Count && remaining_count != 0; n++) + { + if (!remaining_mask.TestBit(n)) + continue; + ImDrawChannel* channel = &splitter->_Channels[n]; + memcpy(dst_tmp++, channel, sizeof(ImDrawChannel)); + remaining_count--; + } + IM_ASSERT(dst_tmp == g.DrawChannelsTempMergeBuffer.Data + g.DrawChannelsTempMergeBuffer.Size); + memcpy(splitter->_Channels.Data + LEADING_DRAW_CHANNELS, g.DrawChannelsTempMergeBuffer.Data, (splitter->_Count - LEADING_DRAW_CHANNELS) * sizeof(ImDrawChannel)); + } +} + +// FIXME-TABLE: This is a mess, need to redesign how we render borders (as some are also done in TableEndRow) +void ImGui::TableDrawBorders(ImGuiTable* table) +{ + ImGuiWindow* inner_window = table->InnerWindow; + if (!table->OuterWindow->ClipRect.Overlaps(table->OuterRect)) + return; + + ImDrawList* inner_drawlist = inner_window->DrawList; + table->DrawSplitter->SetCurrentChannel(inner_drawlist, TABLE_DRAW_CHANNEL_BG0); + inner_drawlist->PushClipRect(table->Bg0ClipRectForDrawCmd.Min, table->Bg0ClipRectForDrawCmd.Max, false); + + // Draw inner border and resizing feedback + const float border_size = TABLE_BORDER_SIZE; + const float draw_y1 = table->InnerRect.Min.y; + const float draw_y2_body = table->InnerRect.Max.y; + const float draw_y2_head = table->IsUsingHeaders ? ImMin(table->InnerRect.Max.y, (table->FreezeRowsCount >= 1 ? table->InnerRect.Min.y : table->WorkRect.Min.y) + table->LastFirstRowHeight) : draw_y1; + if (table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_BordersInnerV) + { + for (int order_n = 0; order_n < table->ColumnsCount; order_n++) + { + if (!(table->EnabledMaskByDisplayOrder & ((ImU64)1 << order_n))) + continue; + + const int column_n = table->DisplayOrderToIndex[order_n]; + ImGuiTableColumn* column = &table->Columns[column_n]; + const bool is_hovered = (table->HoveredColumnBorder == column_n); + const bool is_resized = (table->ResizedColumn == column_n) && (table->InstanceInteracted == table->InstanceCurrent); + const bool is_resizable = (column->Flags & (ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoResize | ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoDirectResize_)) == 0; + const bool is_frozen_separator = (table->FreezeColumnsCount == order_n + 1); + if (column->MaxX > table->InnerClipRect.Max.x && !is_resized) + continue; + + // Decide whether right-most column is visible + if (column->NextEnabledColumn == -1 && !is_resizable) + if ((table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_SizingMask_) != ImGuiTableFlags_SizingFixedSame || (table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_NoHostExtendX)) + continue; + if (column->MaxX <= column->ClipRect.Min.x) // FIXME-TABLE FIXME-STYLE: Assume BorderSize==1, this is problematic if we want to increase the border size.. + continue; + + // Draw in outer window so right-most column won't be clipped + // Always draw full height border when being resized/hovered, or on the delimitation of frozen column scrolling. + ImU32 col; + float draw_y2; + if (is_hovered || is_resized || is_frozen_separator) + { + draw_y2 = draw_y2_body; + col = is_resized ? GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_SeparatorActive) : is_hovered ? GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_SeparatorHovered) : table->BorderColorStrong; + } + else + { + draw_y2 = (table->Flags & (ImGuiTableFlags_NoBordersInBody | ImGuiTableFlags_NoBordersInBodyUntilResize)) ? draw_y2_head : draw_y2_body; + col = (table->Flags & (ImGuiTableFlags_NoBordersInBody | ImGuiTableFlags_NoBordersInBodyUntilResize)) ? table->BorderColorStrong : table->BorderColorLight; + } + + if (draw_y2 > draw_y1) + inner_drawlist->AddLine(ImVec2(column->MaxX, draw_y1), ImVec2(column->MaxX, draw_y2), col, border_size); + } + } + + // Draw outer border + // FIXME: could use AddRect or explicit VLine/HLine helper? + if (table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_BordersOuter) + { + // Display outer border offset by 1 which is a simple way to display it without adding an extra draw call + // (Without the offset, in outer_window it would be rendered behind cells, because child windows are above their + // parent. In inner_window, it won't reach out over scrollbars. Another weird solution would be to display part + // of it in inner window, and the part that's over scrollbars in the outer window..) + // Either solution currently won't allow us to use a larger border size: the border would clipped. + const ImRect outer_border = table->OuterRect; + const ImU32 outer_col = table->BorderColorStrong; + if ((table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_BordersOuter) == ImGuiTableFlags_BordersOuter) + { + inner_drawlist->AddRect(outer_border.Min, outer_border.Max, outer_col, 0.0f, 0, border_size); + } + else if (table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_BordersOuterV) + { + inner_drawlist->AddLine(outer_border.Min, ImVec2(outer_border.Min.x, outer_border.Max.y), outer_col, border_size); + inner_drawlist->AddLine(ImVec2(outer_border.Max.x, outer_border.Min.y), outer_border.Max, outer_col, border_size); + } + else if (table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_BordersOuterH) + { + inner_drawlist->AddLine(outer_border.Min, ImVec2(outer_border.Max.x, outer_border.Min.y), outer_col, border_size); + inner_drawlist->AddLine(ImVec2(outer_border.Min.x, outer_border.Max.y), outer_border.Max, outer_col, border_size); + } + } + if ((table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_BordersInnerH) && table->RowPosY2 < table->OuterRect.Max.y) + { + // Draw bottom-most row border + const float border_y = table->RowPosY2; + if (border_y >= table->BgClipRect.Min.y && border_y < table->BgClipRect.Max.y) + inner_drawlist->AddLine(ImVec2(table->BorderX1, border_y), ImVec2(table->BorderX2, border_y), table->BorderColorLight, border_size); + } + + inner_drawlist->PopClipRect(); +} + +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Tables: Sorting +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// - TableGetSortSpecs() +// - TableFixColumnSortDirection() [Internal] +// - TableGetColumnNextSortDirection() [Internal] +// - TableSetColumnSortDirection() [Internal] +// - TableSortSpecsSanitize() [Internal] +// - TableSortSpecsBuild() [Internal] +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// Return NULL if no sort specs (most often when ImGuiTableFlags_Sortable is not set) +// You can sort your data again when 'SpecsChanged == true'. It will be true with sorting specs have changed since +// last call, or the first time. +// Lifetime: don't hold on this pointer over multiple frames or past any subsequent call to BeginTable()! +ImGuiTableSortSpecs* ImGui::TableGetSortSpecs() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiTable* table = g.CurrentTable; + IM_ASSERT(table != NULL); + + if (!(table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_Sortable)) + return NULL; + + // Require layout (in case TableHeadersRow() hasn't been called) as it may alter IsSortSpecsDirty in some paths. + if (!table->IsLayoutLocked) + TableUpdateLayout(table); + + TableSortSpecsBuild(table); + + return &table->SortSpecs; +} + +static inline ImGuiSortDirection TableGetColumnAvailSortDirection(ImGuiTableColumn* column, int n) +{ + IM_ASSERT(n < column->SortDirectionsAvailCount); + return (column->SortDirectionsAvailList >> (n << 1)) & 0x03; +} + +// Fix sort direction if currently set on a value which is unavailable (e.g. activating NoSortAscending/NoSortDescending) +void ImGui::TableFixColumnSortDirection(ImGuiTable* table, ImGuiTableColumn* column) +{ + if (column->SortOrder == -1 || (column->SortDirectionsAvailMask & (1 << column->SortDirection)) != 0) + return; + column->SortDirection = (ImU8)TableGetColumnAvailSortDirection(column, 0); + table->IsSortSpecsDirty = true; +} + +// Calculate next sort direction that would be set after clicking the column +// - If the PreferSortDescending flag is set, we will default to a Descending direction on the first click. +// - Note that the PreferSortAscending flag is never checked, it is essentially the default and therefore a no-op. +IM_STATIC_ASSERT(ImGuiSortDirection_None == 0 && ImGuiSortDirection_Ascending == 1 && ImGuiSortDirection_Descending == 2); +ImGuiSortDirection ImGui::TableGetColumnNextSortDirection(ImGuiTableColumn* column) +{ + IM_ASSERT(column->SortDirectionsAvailCount > 0); + if (column->SortOrder == -1) + return TableGetColumnAvailSortDirection(column, 0); + for (int n = 0; n < 3; n++) + if (column->SortDirection == TableGetColumnAvailSortDirection(column, n)) + return TableGetColumnAvailSortDirection(column, (n + 1) % column->SortDirectionsAvailCount); + IM_ASSERT(0); + return ImGuiSortDirection_None; +} + +// Note that the NoSortAscending/NoSortDescending flags are processed in TableSortSpecsSanitize(), and they may change/revert +// the value of SortDirection. We could technically also do it here but it would be unnecessary and duplicate code. +void ImGui::TableSetColumnSortDirection(int column_n, ImGuiSortDirection sort_direction, bool append_to_sort_specs) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiTable* table = g.CurrentTable; + + if (!(table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_SortMulti)) + append_to_sort_specs = false; + if (!(table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_SortTristate)) + IM_ASSERT(sort_direction != ImGuiSortDirection_None); + + ImGuiTableColumnIdx sort_order_max = 0; + if (append_to_sort_specs) + for (int other_column_n = 0; other_column_n < table->ColumnsCount; other_column_n++) + sort_order_max = ImMax(sort_order_max, table->Columns[other_column_n].SortOrder); + + ImGuiTableColumn* column = &table->Columns[column_n]; + column->SortDirection = (ImU8)sort_direction; + if (column->SortDirection == ImGuiSortDirection_None) + column->SortOrder = -1; + else if (column->SortOrder == -1 || !append_to_sort_specs) + column->SortOrder = append_to_sort_specs ? sort_order_max + 1 : 0; + + for (int other_column_n = 0; other_column_n < table->ColumnsCount; other_column_n++) + { + ImGuiTableColumn* other_column = &table->Columns[other_column_n]; + if (other_column != column && !append_to_sort_specs) + other_column->SortOrder = -1; + TableFixColumnSortDirection(table, other_column); + } + table->IsSettingsDirty = true; + table->IsSortSpecsDirty = true; +} + +void ImGui::TableSortSpecsSanitize(ImGuiTable* table) +{ + IM_ASSERT(table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_Sortable); + + // Clear SortOrder from hidden column and verify that there's no gap or duplicate. + int sort_order_count = 0; + ImU64 sort_order_mask = 0x00; + for (int column_n = 0; column_n < table->ColumnsCount; column_n++) + { + ImGuiTableColumn* column = &table->Columns[column_n]; + if (column->SortOrder != -1 && !column->IsEnabled) + column->SortOrder = -1; + if (column->SortOrder == -1) + continue; + sort_order_count++; + sort_order_mask |= ((ImU64)1 << column->SortOrder); + IM_ASSERT(sort_order_count < (int)sizeof(sort_order_mask) * 8); + } + + const bool need_fix_linearize = ((ImU64)1 << sort_order_count) != (sort_order_mask + 1); + const bool need_fix_single_sort_order = (sort_order_count > 1) && !(table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_SortMulti); + if (need_fix_linearize || need_fix_single_sort_order) + { + ImU64 fixed_mask = 0x00; + for (int sort_n = 0; sort_n < sort_order_count; sort_n++) + { + // Fix: Rewrite sort order fields if needed so they have no gap or duplicate. + // (e.g. SortOrder 0 disappeared, SortOrder 1..2 exists --> rewrite then as SortOrder 0..1) + int column_with_smallest_sort_order = -1; + for (int column_n = 0; column_n < table->ColumnsCount; column_n++) + if ((fixed_mask & ((ImU64)1 << (ImU64)column_n)) == 0 && table->Columns[column_n].SortOrder != -1) + if (column_with_smallest_sort_order == -1 || table->Columns[column_n].SortOrder < table->Columns[column_with_smallest_sort_order].SortOrder) + column_with_smallest_sort_order = column_n; + IM_ASSERT(column_with_smallest_sort_order != -1); + fixed_mask |= ((ImU64)1 << column_with_smallest_sort_order); + table->Columns[column_with_smallest_sort_order].SortOrder = (ImGuiTableColumnIdx)sort_n; + + // Fix: Make sure only one column has a SortOrder if ImGuiTableFlags_MultiSortable is not set. + if (need_fix_single_sort_order) + { + sort_order_count = 1; + for (int column_n = 0; column_n < table->ColumnsCount; column_n++) + if (column_n != column_with_smallest_sort_order) + table->Columns[column_n].SortOrder = -1; + break; + } + } + } + + // Fallback default sort order (if no column had the ImGuiTableColumnFlags_DefaultSort flag) + if (sort_order_count == 0 && !(table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_SortTristate)) + for (int column_n = 0; column_n < table->ColumnsCount; column_n++) + { + ImGuiTableColumn* column = &table->Columns[column_n]; + if (column->IsEnabled && !(column->Flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoSort)) + { + sort_order_count = 1; + column->SortOrder = 0; + column->SortDirection = (ImU8)TableGetColumnAvailSortDirection(column, 0); + break; + } + } + + table->SortSpecsCount = (ImGuiTableColumnIdx)sort_order_count; +} + +void ImGui::TableSortSpecsBuild(ImGuiTable* table) +{ + bool dirty = table->IsSortSpecsDirty; + if (dirty) + { + TableSortSpecsSanitize(table); + table->SortSpecsMulti.resize(table->SortSpecsCount <= 1 ? 0 : table->SortSpecsCount); + table->SortSpecs.SpecsDirty = true; // Mark as dirty for user + table->IsSortSpecsDirty = false; // Mark as not dirty for us + } + + // Write output + ImGuiTableColumnSortSpecs* sort_specs = (table->SortSpecsCount == 0) ? NULL : (table->SortSpecsCount == 1) ? &table->SortSpecsSingle : table->SortSpecsMulti.Data; + if (dirty && sort_specs != NULL) + for (int column_n = 0; column_n < table->ColumnsCount; column_n++) + { + ImGuiTableColumn* column = &table->Columns[column_n]; + if (column->SortOrder == -1) + continue; + IM_ASSERT(column->SortOrder < table->SortSpecsCount); + ImGuiTableColumnSortSpecs* sort_spec = &sort_specs[column->SortOrder]; + sort_spec->ColumnUserID = column->UserID; + sort_spec->ColumnIndex = (ImGuiTableColumnIdx)column_n; + sort_spec->SortOrder = (ImGuiTableColumnIdx)column->SortOrder; + sort_spec->SortDirection = column->SortDirection; + } + + table->SortSpecs.Specs = sort_specs; + table->SortSpecs.SpecsCount = table->SortSpecsCount; +} + +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Tables: Headers +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// - TableGetHeaderRowHeight() [Internal] +// - TableHeadersRow() +// - TableHeader() +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +float ImGui::TableGetHeaderRowHeight() +{ + // Caring for a minor edge case: + // Calculate row height, for the unlikely case that some labels may be taller than others. + // If we didn't do that, uneven header height would highlight but smaller one before the tallest wouldn't catch input for all height. + // In your custom header row you may omit this all together and just call TableNextRow() without a height... + float row_height = GetTextLineHeight(); + int columns_count = TableGetColumnCount(); + for (int column_n = 0; column_n < columns_count; column_n++) + { + ImGuiTableColumnFlags flags = TableGetColumnFlags(column_n); + if ((flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_IsEnabled) && !(flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoHeaderLabel)) + row_height = ImMax(row_height, CalcTextSize(TableGetColumnName(column_n)).y); + } + row_height += GetStyle().CellPadding.y * 2.0f; + return row_height; +} + +// [Public] This is a helper to output TableHeader() calls based on the column names declared in TableSetupColumn(). +// The intent is that advanced users willing to create customized headers would not need to use this helper +// and can create their own! For example: TableHeader() may be preceeded by Checkbox() or other custom widgets. +// See 'Demo->Tables->Custom headers' for a demonstration of implementing a custom version of this. +// This code is constructed to not make much use of internal functions, as it is intended to be a template to copy. +// FIXME-TABLE: TableOpenContextMenu() and TableGetHeaderRowHeight() are not public. +void ImGui::TableHeadersRow() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiTable* table = g.CurrentTable; + IM_ASSERT(table != NULL && "Need to call TableHeadersRow() after BeginTable()!"); + + // Layout if not already done (this is automatically done by TableNextRow, we do it here solely to facilitate stepping in debugger as it is frequent to step in TableUpdateLayout) + if (!table->IsLayoutLocked) + TableUpdateLayout(table); + + // Open row + const float row_y1 = GetCursorScreenPos().y; + const float row_height = TableGetHeaderRowHeight(); + TableNextRow(ImGuiTableRowFlags_Headers, row_height); + if (table->HostSkipItems) // Merely an optimization, you may skip in your own code. + return; + + const int columns_count = TableGetColumnCount(); + for (int column_n = 0; column_n < columns_count; column_n++) + { + if (!TableSetColumnIndex(column_n)) + continue; + + // Push an id to allow unnamed labels (generally accidental, but let's behave nicely with them) + // - in your own code you may omit the PushID/PopID all-together, provided you know they won't collide + // - table->InstanceCurrent is only >0 when we use multiple BeginTable/EndTable calls with same identifier. + const char* name = (TableGetColumnFlags(column_n) & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoHeaderLabel) ? "" : TableGetColumnName(column_n); + PushID(table->InstanceCurrent * table->ColumnsCount + column_n); + TableHeader(name); + PopID(); + } + + // Allow opening popup from the right-most section after the last column. + ImVec2 mouse_pos = ImGui::GetMousePos(); + if (IsMouseReleased(1) && TableGetHoveredColumn() == columns_count) + if (mouse_pos.y >= row_y1 && mouse_pos.y < row_y1 + row_height) + TableOpenContextMenu(-1); // Will open a non-column-specific popup. +} + +// Emit a column header (text + optional sort order) +// We cpu-clip text here so that all columns headers can be merged into a same draw call. +// Note that because of how we cpu-clip and display sorting indicators, you _cannot_ use SameLine() after a TableHeader() +void ImGui::TableHeader(const char* label) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + if (window->SkipItems) + return; + + ImGuiTable* table = g.CurrentTable; + IM_ASSERT(table != NULL && "Need to call TableHeader() after BeginTable()!"); + IM_ASSERT(table->CurrentColumn != -1); + const int column_n = table->CurrentColumn; + ImGuiTableColumn* column = &table->Columns[column_n]; + + // Label + if (label == NULL) + label = ""; + const char* label_end = FindRenderedTextEnd(label); + ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, label_end, true); + ImVec2 label_pos = window->DC.CursorPos; + + // If we already got a row height, there's use that. + // FIXME-TABLE: Padding problem if the correct outer-padding CellBgRect strays off our ClipRect? + ImRect cell_r = TableGetCellBgRect(table, column_n); + float label_height = ImMax(label_size.y, table->RowMinHeight - table->CellPaddingY * 2.0f); + + // Calculate ideal size for sort order arrow + float w_arrow = 0.0f; + float w_sort_text = 0.0f; + char sort_order_suf[4] = ""; + const float ARROW_SCALE = 0.65f; + if ((table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_Sortable) && !(column->Flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoSort)) + { + w_arrow = ImFloor(g.FontSize * ARROW_SCALE + g.Style.FramePadding.x); + if (column->SortOrder > 0) + { + ImFormatString(sort_order_suf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(sort_order_suf), "%d", column->SortOrder + 1); + w_sort_text = g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x + CalcTextSize(sort_order_suf).x; + } + } + + // We feed our unclipped width to the column without writing on CursorMaxPos, so that column is still considering for merging. + float max_pos_x = label_pos.x + label_size.x + w_sort_text + w_arrow; + column->ContentMaxXHeadersUsed = ImMax(column->ContentMaxXHeadersUsed, column->WorkMaxX); + column->ContentMaxXHeadersIdeal = ImMax(column->ContentMaxXHeadersIdeal, max_pos_x); + + // Keep header highlighted when context menu is open. + const bool selected = (table->IsContextPopupOpen && table->ContextPopupColumn == column_n && table->InstanceInteracted == table->InstanceCurrent); + ImGuiID id = window->GetID(label); + ImRect bb(cell_r.Min.x, cell_r.Min.y, cell_r.Max.x, ImMax(cell_r.Max.y, cell_r.Min.y + label_height + g.Style.CellPadding.y * 2.0f)); + ItemSize(ImVec2(0.0f, label_height)); // Don't declare unclipped width, it'll be fed ContentMaxPosHeadersIdeal + if (!ItemAdd(bb, id)) + return; + + //GetForegroundDrawList()->AddRect(cell_r.Min, cell_r.Max, IM_COL32(255, 0, 0, 255)); // [DEBUG] + //GetForegroundDrawList()->AddRect(bb.Min, bb.Max, IM_COL32(255, 0, 0, 255)); // [DEBUG] + + // Using AllowItemOverlap mode because we cover the whole cell, and we want user to be able to submit subsequent items. + bool hovered, held; + bool pressed = ButtonBehavior(bb, id, &hovered, &held, ImGuiButtonFlags_AllowItemOverlap); + if (g.ActiveId != id) + SetItemAllowOverlap(); + if (held || hovered || selected) + { + const ImU32 col = GetColorU32(held ? ImGuiCol_HeaderActive : hovered ? ImGuiCol_HeaderHovered : ImGuiCol_Header); + //RenderFrame(bb.Min, bb.Max, col, false, 0.0f); + TableSetBgColor(ImGuiTableBgTarget_CellBg, col, table->CurrentColumn); + } + else + { + // Submit single cell bg color in the case we didn't submit a full header row + if ((table->RowFlags & ImGuiTableRowFlags_Headers) == 0) + TableSetBgColor(ImGuiTableBgTarget_CellBg, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_TableHeaderBg), table->CurrentColumn); + } + RenderNavHighlight(bb, id, ImGuiNavHighlightFlags_TypeThin | ImGuiNavHighlightFlags_NoRounding); + if (held) + table->HeldHeaderColumn = (ImGuiTableColumnIdx)column_n; + window->DC.CursorPos.y -= g.Style.ItemSpacing.y * 0.5f; + + // Drag and drop to re-order columns. + // FIXME-TABLE: Scroll request while reordering a column and it lands out of the scrolling zone. + if (held && (table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_Reorderable) && IsMouseDragging(0) && !g.DragDropActive) + { + // While moving a column it will jump on the other side of the mouse, so we also test for MouseDelta.x + table->ReorderColumn = (ImGuiTableColumnIdx)column_n; + table->InstanceInteracted = table->InstanceCurrent; + + // We don't reorder: through the frozen<>unfrozen line, or through a column that is marked with ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoReorder. + if (g.IO.MouseDelta.x < 0.0f && g.IO.MousePos.x < cell_r.Min.x) + if (ImGuiTableColumn* prev_column = (column->PrevEnabledColumn != -1) ? &table->Columns[column->PrevEnabledColumn] : NULL) + if (!((column->Flags | prev_column->Flags) & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoReorder)) + if ((column->IndexWithinEnabledSet < table->FreezeColumnsRequest) == (prev_column->IndexWithinEnabledSet < table->FreezeColumnsRequest)) + table->ReorderColumnDir = -1; + if (g.IO.MouseDelta.x > 0.0f && g.IO.MousePos.x > cell_r.Max.x) + if (ImGuiTableColumn* next_column = (column->NextEnabledColumn != -1) ? &table->Columns[column->NextEnabledColumn] : NULL) + if (!((column->Flags | next_column->Flags) & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoReorder)) + if ((column->IndexWithinEnabledSet < table->FreezeColumnsRequest) == (next_column->IndexWithinEnabledSet < table->FreezeColumnsRequest)) + table->ReorderColumnDir = +1; + } + + // Sort order arrow + const float ellipsis_max = cell_r.Max.x - w_arrow - w_sort_text; + if ((table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_Sortable) && !(column->Flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoSort)) + { + if (column->SortOrder != -1) + { + float x = ImMax(cell_r.Min.x, cell_r.Max.x - w_arrow - w_sort_text); + float y = label_pos.y; + if (column->SortOrder > 0) + { + PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_Text, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text, 0.70f)); + RenderText(ImVec2(x + g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x, y), sort_order_suf); + PopStyleColor(); + x += w_sort_text; + } + RenderArrow(window->DrawList, ImVec2(x, y), GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text), column->SortDirection == ImGuiSortDirection_Ascending ? ImGuiDir_Up : ImGuiDir_Down, ARROW_SCALE); + } + + // Handle clicking on column header to adjust Sort Order + if (pressed && table->ReorderColumn != column_n) + { + ImGuiSortDirection sort_direction = TableGetColumnNextSortDirection(column); + TableSetColumnSortDirection(column_n, sort_direction, g.IO.KeyShift); + } + } + + // Render clipped label. Clipping here ensure that in the majority of situations, all our header cells will + // be merged into a single draw call. + //window->DrawList->AddCircleFilled(ImVec2(ellipsis_max, label_pos.y), 40, IM_COL32_WHITE); + RenderTextEllipsis(window->DrawList, label_pos, ImVec2(ellipsis_max, label_pos.y + label_height + g.Style.FramePadding.y), ellipsis_max, ellipsis_max, label, label_end, &label_size); + + const bool text_clipped = label_size.x > (ellipsis_max - label_pos.x); + if (text_clipped && hovered && g.HoveredIdNotActiveTimer > g.TooltipSlowDelay) + SetTooltip("%.*s", (int)(label_end - label), label); + + // We don't use BeginPopupContextItem() because we want the popup to stay up even after the column is hidden + if (IsMouseReleased(1) && IsItemHovered()) + TableOpenContextMenu(column_n); +} + +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Tables: Context Menu +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// - TableOpenContextMenu() [Internal] +// - TableDrawContextMenu() [Internal] +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// Use -1 to open menu not specific to a given column. +void ImGui::TableOpenContextMenu(int column_n) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiTable* table = g.CurrentTable; + if (column_n == -1 && table->CurrentColumn != -1) // When called within a column automatically use this one (for consistency) + column_n = table->CurrentColumn; + if (column_n == table->ColumnsCount) // To facilitate using with TableGetHoveredColumn() + column_n = -1; + IM_ASSERT(column_n >= -1 && column_n < table->ColumnsCount); + if (table->Flags & (ImGuiTableFlags_Resizable | ImGuiTableFlags_Reorderable | ImGuiTableFlags_Hideable)) + { + table->IsContextPopupOpen = true; + table->ContextPopupColumn = (ImGuiTableColumnIdx)column_n; + table->InstanceInteracted = table->InstanceCurrent; + const ImGuiID context_menu_id = ImHashStr("##ContextMenu", 0, table->ID); + OpenPopupEx(context_menu_id, ImGuiPopupFlags_None); + } +} + +// Output context menu into current window (generally a popup) +// FIXME-TABLE: Ideally this should be writable by the user. Full programmatic access to that data? +void ImGui::TableDrawContextMenu(ImGuiTable* table) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + if (window->SkipItems) + return; + + bool want_separator = false; + const int column_n = (table->ContextPopupColumn >= 0 && table->ContextPopupColumn < table->ColumnsCount) ? table->ContextPopupColumn : -1; + ImGuiTableColumn* column = (column_n != -1) ? &table->Columns[column_n] : NULL; + + // Sizing + if (table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_Resizable) + { + if (column != NULL) + { + const bool can_resize = !(column->Flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoResize) && column->IsEnabled; + if (MenuItem("Size column to fit###SizeOne", NULL, false, can_resize)) + TableSetColumnWidthAutoSingle(table, column_n); + } + + const char* size_all_desc; + if (table->ColumnsEnabledFixedCount == table->ColumnsEnabledCount && (table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_SizingMask_) != ImGuiTableFlags_SizingFixedSame) + size_all_desc = "Size all columns to fit###SizeAll"; // All fixed + else + size_all_desc = "Size all columns to default###SizeAll"; // All stretch or mixed + if (MenuItem(size_all_desc, NULL)) + TableSetColumnWidthAutoAll(table); + want_separator = true; + } + + // Ordering + if (table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_Reorderable) + { + if (MenuItem("Reset order", NULL, false, !table->IsDefaultDisplayOrder)) + table->IsResetDisplayOrderRequest = true; + want_separator = true; + } + + // Reset all (should work but seems unnecessary/noisy to expose?) + //if (MenuItem("Reset all")) + // table->IsResetAllRequest = true; + + // Sorting + // (modify TableOpenContextMenu() to add _Sortable flag if enabling this) +#if 0 + if ((table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_Sortable) && column != NULL && (column->Flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoSort) == 0) + { + if (want_separator) + Separator(); + want_separator = true; + + bool append_to_sort_specs = g.IO.KeyShift; + if (MenuItem("Sort in Ascending Order", NULL, column->SortOrder != -1 && column->SortDirection == ImGuiSortDirection_Ascending, (column->Flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoSortAscending) == 0)) + TableSetColumnSortDirection(table, column_n, ImGuiSortDirection_Ascending, append_to_sort_specs); + if (MenuItem("Sort in Descending Order", NULL, column->SortOrder != -1 && column->SortDirection == ImGuiSortDirection_Descending, (column->Flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoSortDescending) == 0)) + TableSetColumnSortDirection(table, column_n, ImGuiSortDirection_Descending, append_to_sort_specs); + } +#endif + + // Hiding / Visibility + if (table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_Hideable) + { + if (want_separator) + Separator(); + want_separator = true; + + PushItemFlag(ImGuiItemFlags_SelectableDontClosePopup, true); + for (int other_column_n = 0; other_column_n < table->ColumnsCount; other_column_n++) + { + ImGuiTableColumn* other_column = &table->Columns[other_column_n]; + if (other_column->Flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_Disabled) + continue; + + const char* name = TableGetColumnName(table, other_column_n); + if (name == NULL || name[0] == 0) + name = ""; + + // Make sure we can't hide the last active column + bool menu_item_active = (other_column->Flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoHide) ? false : true; + if (other_column->IsUserEnabled && table->ColumnsEnabledCount <= 1) + menu_item_active = false; + if (MenuItem(name, NULL, other_column->IsUserEnabled, menu_item_active)) + other_column->IsUserEnabledNextFrame = !other_column->IsUserEnabled; + } + PopItemFlag(); + } +} + +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Tables: Settings (.ini data) +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// FIXME: The binding/finding/creating flow are too confusing. +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// - TableSettingsInit() [Internal] +// - TableSettingsCalcChunkSize() [Internal] +// - TableSettingsCreate() [Internal] +// - TableSettingsFindByID() [Internal] +// - TableGetBoundSettings() [Internal] +// - TableResetSettings() +// - TableSaveSettings() [Internal] +// - TableLoadSettings() [Internal] +// - TableSettingsHandler_ClearAll() [Internal] +// - TableSettingsHandler_ApplyAll() [Internal] +// - TableSettingsHandler_ReadOpen() [Internal] +// - TableSettingsHandler_ReadLine() [Internal] +// - TableSettingsHandler_WriteAll() [Internal] +// - TableSettingsInstallHandler() [Internal] +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [Init] 1: TableSettingsHandler_ReadXXXX() Load and parse .ini file into TableSettings. +// [Main] 2: TableLoadSettings() When table is created, bind Table to TableSettings, serialize TableSettings data into Table. +// [Main] 3: TableSaveSettings() When table properties are modified, serialize Table data into bound or new TableSettings, mark .ini as dirty. +// [Main] 4: TableSettingsHandler_WriteAll() When .ini file is dirty (which can come from other source), save TableSettings into .ini file. +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// Clear and initialize empty settings instance +static void TableSettingsInit(ImGuiTableSettings* settings, ImGuiID id, int columns_count, int columns_count_max) +{ + IM_PLACEMENT_NEW(settings) ImGuiTableSettings(); + ImGuiTableColumnSettings* settings_column = settings->GetColumnSettings(); + for (int n = 0; n < columns_count_max; n++, settings_column++) + IM_PLACEMENT_NEW(settings_column) ImGuiTableColumnSettings(); + settings->ID = id; + settings->ColumnsCount = (ImGuiTableColumnIdx)columns_count; + settings->ColumnsCountMax = (ImGuiTableColumnIdx)columns_count_max; + settings->WantApply = true; +} + +static size_t TableSettingsCalcChunkSize(int columns_count) +{ + return sizeof(ImGuiTableSettings) + (size_t)columns_count * sizeof(ImGuiTableColumnSettings); +} + +ImGuiTableSettings* ImGui::TableSettingsCreate(ImGuiID id, int columns_count) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiTableSettings* settings = g.SettingsTables.alloc_chunk(TableSettingsCalcChunkSize(columns_count)); + TableSettingsInit(settings, id, columns_count, columns_count); + return settings; +} + +// Find existing settings +ImGuiTableSettings* ImGui::TableSettingsFindByID(ImGuiID id) +{ + // FIXME-OPT: Might want to store a lookup map for this? + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + for (ImGuiTableSettings* settings = g.SettingsTables.begin(); settings != NULL; settings = g.SettingsTables.next_chunk(settings)) + if (settings->ID == id) + return settings; + return NULL; +} + +// Get settings for a given table, NULL if none +ImGuiTableSettings* ImGui::TableGetBoundSettings(ImGuiTable* table) +{ + if (table->SettingsOffset != -1) + { + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiTableSettings* settings = g.SettingsTables.ptr_from_offset(table->SettingsOffset); + IM_ASSERT(settings->ID == table->ID); + if (settings->ColumnsCountMax >= table->ColumnsCount) + return settings; // OK + settings->ID = 0; // Invalidate storage, we won't fit because of a count change + } + return NULL; +} + +// Restore initial state of table (with or without saved settings) +void ImGui::TableResetSettings(ImGuiTable* table) +{ + table->IsInitializing = table->IsSettingsDirty = true; + table->IsResetAllRequest = false; + table->IsSettingsRequestLoad = false; // Don't reload from ini + table->SettingsLoadedFlags = ImGuiTableFlags_None; // Mark as nothing loaded so our initialized data becomes authoritative +} + +void ImGui::TableSaveSettings(ImGuiTable* table) +{ + table->IsSettingsDirty = false; + if (table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_NoSavedSettings) + return; + + // Bind or create settings data + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiTableSettings* settings = TableGetBoundSettings(table); + if (settings == NULL) + { + settings = TableSettingsCreate(table->ID, table->ColumnsCount); + table->SettingsOffset = g.SettingsTables.offset_from_ptr(settings); + } + settings->ColumnsCount = (ImGuiTableColumnIdx)table->ColumnsCount; + + // Serialize ImGuiTable/ImGuiTableColumn into ImGuiTableSettings/ImGuiTableColumnSettings + IM_ASSERT(settings->ID == table->ID); + IM_ASSERT(settings->ColumnsCount == table->ColumnsCount && settings->ColumnsCountMax >= settings->ColumnsCount); + ImGuiTableColumn* column = table->Columns.Data; + ImGuiTableColumnSettings* column_settings = settings->GetColumnSettings(); + + bool save_ref_scale = false; + settings->SaveFlags = ImGuiTableFlags_None; + for (int n = 0; n < table->ColumnsCount; n++, column++, column_settings++) + { + const float width_or_weight = (column->Flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthStretch) ? column->StretchWeight : column->WidthRequest; + column_settings->WidthOrWeight = width_or_weight; + column_settings->Index = (ImGuiTableColumnIdx)n; + column_settings->DisplayOrder = column->DisplayOrder; + column_settings->SortOrder = column->SortOrder; + column_settings->SortDirection = column->SortDirection; + column_settings->IsEnabled = column->IsUserEnabled; + column_settings->IsStretch = (column->Flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthStretch) ? 1 : 0; + if ((column->Flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthStretch) == 0) + save_ref_scale = true; + + // We skip saving some data in the .ini file when they are unnecessary to restore our state. + // Note that fixed width where initial width was derived from auto-fit will always be saved as InitStretchWeightOrWidth will be 0.0f. + // FIXME-TABLE: We don't have logic to easily compare SortOrder to DefaultSortOrder yet so it's always saved when present. + if (width_or_weight != column->InitStretchWeightOrWidth) + settings->SaveFlags |= ImGuiTableFlags_Resizable; + if (column->DisplayOrder != n) + settings->SaveFlags |= ImGuiTableFlags_Reorderable; + if (column->SortOrder != -1) + settings->SaveFlags |= ImGuiTableFlags_Sortable; + if (column->IsUserEnabled != ((column->Flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_DefaultHide) == 0)) + settings->SaveFlags |= ImGuiTableFlags_Hideable; + } + settings->SaveFlags &= table->Flags; + settings->RefScale = save_ref_scale ? table->RefScale : 0.0f; + + MarkIniSettingsDirty(); +} + +void ImGui::TableLoadSettings(ImGuiTable* table) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + table->IsSettingsRequestLoad = false; + if (table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_NoSavedSettings) + return; + + // Bind settings + ImGuiTableSettings* settings; + if (table->SettingsOffset == -1) + { + settings = TableSettingsFindByID(table->ID); + if (settings == NULL) + return; + if (settings->ColumnsCount != table->ColumnsCount) // Allow settings if columns count changed. We could otherwise decide to return... + table->IsSettingsDirty = true; + table->SettingsOffset = g.SettingsTables.offset_from_ptr(settings); + } + else + { + settings = TableGetBoundSettings(table); + } + + table->SettingsLoadedFlags = settings->SaveFlags; + table->RefScale = settings->RefScale; + + // Serialize ImGuiTableSettings/ImGuiTableColumnSettings into ImGuiTable/ImGuiTableColumn + ImGuiTableColumnSettings* column_settings = settings->GetColumnSettings(); + ImU64 display_order_mask = 0; + for (int data_n = 0; data_n < settings->ColumnsCount; data_n++, column_settings++) + { + int column_n = column_settings->Index; + if (column_n < 0 || column_n >= table->ColumnsCount) + continue; + + ImGuiTableColumn* column = &table->Columns[column_n]; + if (settings->SaveFlags & ImGuiTableFlags_Resizable) + { + if (column_settings->IsStretch) + column->StretchWeight = column_settings->WidthOrWeight; + else + column->WidthRequest = column_settings->WidthOrWeight; + column->AutoFitQueue = 0x00; + } + if (settings->SaveFlags & ImGuiTableFlags_Reorderable) + column->DisplayOrder = column_settings->DisplayOrder; + else + column->DisplayOrder = (ImGuiTableColumnIdx)column_n; + display_order_mask |= (ImU64)1 << column->DisplayOrder; + column->IsUserEnabled = column->IsUserEnabledNextFrame = column_settings->IsEnabled; + column->SortOrder = column_settings->SortOrder; + column->SortDirection = column_settings->SortDirection; + } + + // Validate and fix invalid display order data + const ImU64 expected_display_order_mask = (settings->ColumnsCount == 64) ? ~0 : ((ImU64)1 << settings->ColumnsCount) - 1; + if (display_order_mask != expected_display_order_mask) + for (int column_n = 0; column_n < table->ColumnsCount; column_n++) + table->Columns[column_n].DisplayOrder = (ImGuiTableColumnIdx)column_n; + + // Rebuild index + for (int column_n = 0; column_n < table->ColumnsCount; column_n++) + table->DisplayOrderToIndex[table->Columns[column_n].DisplayOrder] = (ImGuiTableColumnIdx)column_n; +} + +static void TableSettingsHandler_ClearAll(ImGuiContext* ctx, ImGuiSettingsHandler*) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *ctx; + for (int i = 0; i != g.Tables.GetMapSize(); i++) + if (ImGuiTable* table = g.Tables.TryGetMapData(i)) + table->SettingsOffset = -1; + g.SettingsTables.clear(); +} + +// Apply to existing windows (if any) +static void TableSettingsHandler_ApplyAll(ImGuiContext* ctx, ImGuiSettingsHandler*) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *ctx; + for (int i = 0; i != g.Tables.GetMapSize(); i++) + if (ImGuiTable* table = g.Tables.TryGetMapData(i)) + { + table->IsSettingsRequestLoad = true; + table->SettingsOffset = -1; + } +} + +static void* TableSettingsHandler_ReadOpen(ImGuiContext*, ImGuiSettingsHandler*, const char* name) +{ + ImGuiID id = 0; + int columns_count = 0; + if (sscanf(name, "0x%08X,%d", &id, &columns_count) < 2) + return NULL; + + if (ImGuiTableSettings* settings = ImGui::TableSettingsFindByID(id)) + { + if (settings->ColumnsCountMax >= columns_count) + { + TableSettingsInit(settings, id, columns_count, settings->ColumnsCountMax); // Recycle + return settings; + } + settings->ID = 0; // Invalidate storage, we won't fit because of a count change + } + return ImGui::TableSettingsCreate(id, columns_count); +} + +static void TableSettingsHandler_ReadLine(ImGuiContext*, ImGuiSettingsHandler*, void* entry, const char* line) +{ + // "Column 0 UserID=0x42AD2D21 Width=100 Visible=1 Order=0 Sort=0v" + ImGuiTableSettings* settings = (ImGuiTableSettings*)entry; + float f = 0.0f; + int column_n = 0, r = 0, n = 0; + + if (sscanf(line, "RefScale=%f", &f) == 1) { settings->RefScale = f; return; } + + if (sscanf(line, "Column %d%n", &column_n, &r) == 1) + { + if (column_n < 0 || column_n >= settings->ColumnsCount) + return; + line = ImStrSkipBlank(line + r); + char c = 0; + ImGuiTableColumnSettings* column = settings->GetColumnSettings() + column_n; + column->Index = (ImGuiTableColumnIdx)column_n; + if (sscanf(line, "UserID=0x%08X%n", (ImU32*)&n, &r)==1) { line = ImStrSkipBlank(line + r); column->UserID = (ImGuiID)n; } + if (sscanf(line, "Width=%d%n", &n, &r) == 1) { line = ImStrSkipBlank(line + r); column->WidthOrWeight = (float)n; column->IsStretch = 0; settings->SaveFlags |= ImGuiTableFlags_Resizable; } + if (sscanf(line, "Weight=%f%n", &f, &r) == 1) { line = ImStrSkipBlank(line + r); column->WidthOrWeight = f; column->IsStretch = 1; settings->SaveFlags |= ImGuiTableFlags_Resizable; } + if (sscanf(line, "Visible=%d%n", &n, &r) == 1) { line = ImStrSkipBlank(line + r); column->IsEnabled = (ImU8)n; settings->SaveFlags |= ImGuiTableFlags_Hideable; } + if (sscanf(line, "Order=%d%n", &n, &r) == 1) { line = ImStrSkipBlank(line + r); column->DisplayOrder = (ImGuiTableColumnIdx)n; settings->SaveFlags |= ImGuiTableFlags_Reorderable; } + if (sscanf(line, "Sort=%d%c%n", &n, &c, &r) == 2) { line = ImStrSkipBlank(line + r); column->SortOrder = (ImGuiTableColumnIdx)n; column->SortDirection = (c == '^') ? ImGuiSortDirection_Descending : ImGuiSortDirection_Ascending; settings->SaveFlags |= ImGuiTableFlags_Sortable; } + } +} + +static void TableSettingsHandler_WriteAll(ImGuiContext* ctx, ImGuiSettingsHandler* handler, ImGuiTextBuffer* buf) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *ctx; + for (ImGuiTableSettings* settings = g.SettingsTables.begin(); settings != NULL; settings = g.SettingsTables.next_chunk(settings)) + { + if (settings->ID == 0) // Skip ditched settings + continue; + + // TableSaveSettings() may clear some of those flags when we establish that the data can be stripped + // (e.g. Order was unchanged) + const bool save_size = (settings->SaveFlags & ImGuiTableFlags_Resizable) != 0; + const bool save_visible = (settings->SaveFlags & ImGuiTableFlags_Hideable) != 0; + const bool save_order = (settings->SaveFlags & ImGuiTableFlags_Reorderable) != 0; + const bool save_sort = (settings->SaveFlags & ImGuiTableFlags_Sortable) != 0; + if (!save_size && !save_visible && !save_order && !save_sort) + continue; + + buf->reserve(buf->size() + 30 + settings->ColumnsCount * 50); // ballpark reserve + buf->appendf("[%s][0x%08X,%d]\n", handler->TypeName, settings->ID, settings->ColumnsCount); + if (settings->RefScale != 0.0f) + buf->appendf("RefScale=%g\n", settings->RefScale); + ImGuiTableColumnSettings* column = settings->GetColumnSettings(); + for (int column_n = 0; column_n < settings->ColumnsCount; column_n++, column++) + { + // "Column 0 UserID=0x42AD2D21 Width=100 Visible=1 Order=0 Sort=0v" + bool save_column = column->UserID != 0 || save_size || save_visible || save_order || (save_sort && column->SortOrder != -1); + if (!save_column) + continue; + buf->appendf("Column %-2d", column_n); + if (column->UserID != 0) buf->appendf(" UserID=%08X", column->UserID); + if (save_size && column->IsStretch) buf->appendf(" Weight=%.4f", column->WidthOrWeight); + if (save_size && !column->IsStretch) buf->appendf(" Width=%d", (int)column->WidthOrWeight); + if (save_visible) buf->appendf(" Visible=%d", column->IsEnabled); + if (save_order) buf->appendf(" Order=%d", column->DisplayOrder); + if (save_sort && column->SortOrder != -1) buf->appendf(" Sort=%d%c", column->SortOrder, (column->SortDirection == ImGuiSortDirection_Ascending) ? 'v' : '^'); + buf->append("\n"); + } + buf->append("\n"); + } +} + +void ImGui::TableSettingsInstallHandler(ImGuiContext* context) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *context; + ImGuiSettingsHandler ini_handler; + ini_handler.TypeName = "Table"; + ini_handler.TypeHash = ImHashStr("Table"); + ini_handler.ClearAllFn = TableSettingsHandler_ClearAll; + ini_handler.ReadOpenFn = TableSettingsHandler_ReadOpen; + ini_handler.ReadLineFn = TableSettingsHandler_ReadLine; + ini_handler.ApplyAllFn = TableSettingsHandler_ApplyAll; + ini_handler.WriteAllFn = TableSettingsHandler_WriteAll; + g.SettingsHandlers.push_back(ini_handler); +} + +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Tables: Garbage Collection +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// - TableRemove() [Internal] +// - TableGcCompactTransientBuffers() [Internal] +// - TableGcCompactSettings() [Internal] +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// Remove Table (currently only used by TestEngine) +void ImGui::TableRemove(ImGuiTable* table) +{ + //IMGUI_DEBUG_LOG("TableRemove() id=0x%08X\n", table->ID); + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + int table_idx = g.Tables.GetIndex(table); + //memset(table->RawData.Data, 0, table->RawData.size_in_bytes()); + //memset(table, 0, sizeof(ImGuiTable)); + g.Tables.Remove(table->ID, table); + g.TablesLastTimeActive[table_idx] = -1.0f; +} + +// Free up/compact internal Table buffers for when it gets unused +void ImGui::TableGcCompactTransientBuffers(ImGuiTable* table) +{ + //IMGUI_DEBUG_LOG("TableGcCompactTransientBuffers() id=0x%08X\n", table->ID); + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + IM_ASSERT(table->MemoryCompacted == false); + table->SortSpecs.Specs = NULL; + table->SortSpecsMulti.clear(); + table->IsSortSpecsDirty = true; // FIXME: shouldn't have to leak into user performing a sort + table->ColumnsNames.clear(); + table->MemoryCompacted = true; + for (int n = 0; n < table->ColumnsCount; n++) + table->Columns[n].NameOffset = -1; + g.TablesLastTimeActive[g.Tables.GetIndex(table)] = -1.0f; +} + +void ImGui::TableGcCompactTransientBuffers(ImGuiTableTempData* temp_data) +{ + temp_data->DrawSplitter.ClearFreeMemory(); + temp_data->LastTimeActive = -1.0f; +} + +// Compact and remove unused settings data (currently only used by TestEngine) +void ImGui::TableGcCompactSettings() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + int required_memory = 0; + for (ImGuiTableSettings* settings = g.SettingsTables.begin(); settings != NULL; settings = g.SettingsTables.next_chunk(settings)) + if (settings->ID != 0) + required_memory += (int)TableSettingsCalcChunkSize(settings->ColumnsCount); + if (required_memory == g.SettingsTables.Buf.Size) + return; + ImChunkStream new_chunk_stream; + new_chunk_stream.Buf.reserve(required_memory); + for (ImGuiTableSettings* settings = g.SettingsTables.begin(); settings != NULL; settings = g.SettingsTables.next_chunk(settings)) + if (settings->ID != 0) + memcpy(new_chunk_stream.alloc_chunk(TableSettingsCalcChunkSize(settings->ColumnsCount)), settings, TableSettingsCalcChunkSize(settings->ColumnsCount)); + g.SettingsTables.swap(new_chunk_stream); +} + + +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Tables: Debugging +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// - DebugNodeTable() [Internal] +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_METRICS_WINDOW + +static const char* DebugNodeTableGetSizingPolicyDesc(ImGuiTableFlags sizing_policy) +{ + sizing_policy &= ImGuiTableFlags_SizingMask_; + if (sizing_policy == ImGuiTableFlags_SizingFixedFit) { return "FixedFit"; } + if (sizing_policy == ImGuiTableFlags_SizingFixedSame) { return "FixedSame"; } + if (sizing_policy == ImGuiTableFlags_SizingStretchProp) { return "StretchProp"; } + if (sizing_policy == ImGuiTableFlags_SizingStretchSame) { return "StretchSame"; } + return "N/A"; +} + +void ImGui::DebugNodeTable(ImGuiTable* table) +{ + char buf[512]; + char* p = buf; + const char* buf_end = buf + IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf); + const bool is_active = (table->LastFrameActive >= ImGui::GetFrameCount() - 2); // Note that fully clipped early out scrolling tables will appear as inactive here. + ImFormatString(p, buf_end - p, "Table 0x%08X (%d columns, in '%s')%s", table->ID, table->ColumnsCount, table->OuterWindow->Name, is_active ? "" : " *Inactive*"); + if (!is_active) { PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_Text, GetStyleColorVec4(ImGuiCol_TextDisabled)); } + bool open = TreeNode(table, "%s", buf); + if (!is_active) { PopStyleColor(); } + if (IsItemHovered()) + GetForegroundDrawList()->AddRect(table->OuterRect.Min, table->OuterRect.Max, IM_COL32(255, 255, 0, 255)); + if (IsItemVisible() && table->HoveredColumnBody != -1) + GetForegroundDrawList()->AddRect(GetItemRectMin(), GetItemRectMax(), IM_COL32(255, 255, 0, 255)); + if (!open) + return; + bool clear_settings = SmallButton("Clear settings"); + BulletText("OuterRect: Pos: (%.1f,%.1f) Size: (%.1f,%.1f) Sizing: '%s'", table->OuterRect.Min.x, table->OuterRect.Min.y, table->OuterRect.GetWidth(), table->OuterRect.GetHeight(), DebugNodeTableGetSizingPolicyDesc(table->Flags)); + BulletText("ColumnsGivenWidth: %.1f, ColumnsAutoFitWidth: %.1f, InnerWidth: %.1f%s", table->ColumnsGivenWidth, table->ColumnsAutoFitWidth, table->InnerWidth, table->InnerWidth == 0.0f ? " (auto)" : ""); + BulletText("CellPaddingX: %.1f, CellSpacingX: %.1f/%.1f, OuterPaddingX: %.1f", table->CellPaddingX, table->CellSpacingX1, table->CellSpacingX2, table->OuterPaddingX); + BulletText("HoveredColumnBody: %d, HoveredColumnBorder: %d", table->HoveredColumnBody, table->HoveredColumnBorder); + BulletText("ResizedColumn: %d, ReorderColumn: %d, HeldHeaderColumn: %d", table->ResizedColumn, table->ReorderColumn, table->HeldHeaderColumn); + //BulletText("BgDrawChannels: %d/%d", 0, table->BgDrawChannelUnfrozen); + float sum_weights = 0.0f; + for (int n = 0; n < table->ColumnsCount; n++) + if (table->Columns[n].Flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthStretch) + sum_weights += table->Columns[n].StretchWeight; + for (int n = 0; n < table->ColumnsCount; n++) + { + ImGuiTableColumn* column = &table->Columns[n]; + const char* name = TableGetColumnName(table, n); + ImFormatString(buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf), + "Column %d order %d '%s': offset %+.2f to %+.2f%s\n" + "Enabled: %d, VisibleX/Y: %d/%d, RequestOutput: %d, SkipItems: %d, DrawChannels: %d,%d\n" + "WidthGiven: %.1f, Request/Auto: %.1f/%.1f, StretchWeight: %.3f (%.1f%%)\n" + "MinX: %.1f, MaxX: %.1f (%+.1f), ClipRect: %.1f to %.1f (+%.1f)\n" + "ContentWidth: %.1f,%.1f, HeadersUsed/Ideal %.1f/%.1f\n" + "Sort: %d%s, UserID: 0x%08X, Flags: 0x%04X: %s%s%s..", + n, column->DisplayOrder, name, column->MinX - table->WorkRect.Min.x, column->MaxX - table->WorkRect.Min.x, (n < table->FreezeColumnsRequest) ? " (Frozen)" : "", + column->IsEnabled, column->IsVisibleX, column->IsVisibleY, column->IsRequestOutput, column->IsSkipItems, column->DrawChannelFrozen, column->DrawChannelUnfrozen, + column->WidthGiven, column->WidthRequest, column->WidthAuto, column->StretchWeight, column->StretchWeight > 0.0f ? (column->StretchWeight / sum_weights) * 100.0f : 0.0f, + column->MinX, column->MaxX, column->MaxX - column->MinX, column->ClipRect.Min.x, column->ClipRect.Max.x, column->ClipRect.Max.x - column->ClipRect.Min.x, + column->ContentMaxXFrozen - column->WorkMinX, column->ContentMaxXUnfrozen - column->WorkMinX, column->ContentMaxXHeadersUsed - column->WorkMinX, column->ContentMaxXHeadersIdeal - column->WorkMinX, + column->SortOrder, (column->SortDirection == ImGuiSortDirection_Ascending) ? " (Asc)" : (column->SortDirection == ImGuiSortDirection_Descending) ? " (Des)" : "", column->UserID, column->Flags, + (column->Flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthStretch) ? "WidthStretch " : "", + (column->Flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthFixed) ? "WidthFixed " : "", + (column->Flags & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_NoResize) ? "NoResize " : ""); + Bullet(); + Selectable(buf); + if (IsItemHovered()) + { + ImRect r(column->MinX, table->OuterRect.Min.y, column->MaxX, table->OuterRect.Max.y); + GetForegroundDrawList()->AddRect(r.Min, r.Max, IM_COL32(255, 255, 0, 255)); + } + } + if (ImGuiTableSettings* settings = TableGetBoundSettings(table)) + DebugNodeTableSettings(settings); + if (clear_settings) + table->IsResetAllRequest = true; + TreePop(); +} + +void ImGui::DebugNodeTableSettings(ImGuiTableSettings* settings) +{ + if (!TreeNode((void*)(intptr_t)settings->ID, "Settings 0x%08X (%d columns)", settings->ID, settings->ColumnsCount)) + return; + BulletText("SaveFlags: 0x%08X", settings->SaveFlags); + BulletText("ColumnsCount: %d (max %d)", settings->ColumnsCount, settings->ColumnsCountMax); + for (int n = 0; n < settings->ColumnsCount; n++) + { + ImGuiTableColumnSettings* column_settings = &settings->GetColumnSettings()[n]; + ImGuiSortDirection sort_dir = (column_settings->SortOrder != -1) ? (ImGuiSortDirection)column_settings->SortDirection : ImGuiSortDirection_None; + BulletText("Column %d Order %d SortOrder %d %s Vis %d %s %7.3f UserID 0x%08X", + n, column_settings->DisplayOrder, column_settings->SortOrder, + (sort_dir == ImGuiSortDirection_Ascending) ? "Asc" : (sort_dir == ImGuiSortDirection_Descending) ? "Des" : "---", + column_settings->IsEnabled, column_settings->IsStretch ? "Weight" : "Width ", column_settings->WidthOrWeight, column_settings->UserID); + } + TreePop(); +} + +#else // #ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_METRICS_WINDOW + +void ImGui::DebugNodeTable(ImGuiTable*) {} +void ImGui::DebugNodeTableSettings(ImGuiTableSettings*) {} + +#endif + + +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Columns, BeginColumns, EndColumns, etc. +// (This is a legacy API, prefer using BeginTable/EndTable!) +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// FIXME: sizing is lossy when columns width is very small (default width may turn negative etc.) +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// - SetWindowClipRectBeforeSetChannel() [Internal] +// - GetColumnIndex() +// - GetColumnsCount() +// - GetColumnOffset() +// - GetColumnWidth() +// - SetColumnOffset() +// - SetColumnWidth() +// - PushColumnClipRect() [Internal] +// - PushColumnsBackground() [Internal] +// - PopColumnsBackground() [Internal] +// - FindOrCreateColumns() [Internal] +// - GetColumnsID() [Internal] +// - BeginColumns() +// - NextColumn() +// - EndColumns() +// - Columns() +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// [Internal] Small optimization to avoid calls to PopClipRect/SetCurrentChannel/PushClipRect in sequences, +// they would meddle many times with the underlying ImDrawCmd. +// Instead, we do a preemptive overwrite of clipping rectangle _without_ altering the command-buffer and let +// the subsequent single call to SetCurrentChannel() does it things once. +void ImGui::SetWindowClipRectBeforeSetChannel(ImGuiWindow* window, const ImRect& clip_rect) +{ + ImVec4 clip_rect_vec4 = clip_rect.ToVec4(); + window->ClipRect = clip_rect; + window->DrawList->_CmdHeader.ClipRect = clip_rect_vec4; + window->DrawList->_ClipRectStack.Data[window->DrawList->_ClipRectStack.Size - 1] = clip_rect_vec4; +} + +int ImGui::GetColumnIndex() +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead(); + return window->DC.CurrentColumns ? window->DC.CurrentColumns->Current : 0; +} + +int ImGui::GetColumnsCount() +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead(); + return window->DC.CurrentColumns ? window->DC.CurrentColumns->Count : 1; +} + +float ImGui::GetColumnOffsetFromNorm(const ImGuiOldColumns* columns, float offset_norm) +{ + return offset_norm * (columns->OffMaxX - columns->OffMinX); +} + +float ImGui::GetColumnNormFromOffset(const ImGuiOldColumns* columns, float offset) +{ + return offset / (columns->OffMaxX - columns->OffMinX); +} + +static const float COLUMNS_HIT_RECT_HALF_WIDTH = 4.0f; + +static float GetDraggedColumnOffset(ImGuiOldColumns* columns, int column_index) +{ + // Active (dragged) column always follow mouse. The reason we need this is that dragging a column to the right edge of an auto-resizing + // window creates a feedback loop because we store normalized positions. So while dragging we enforce absolute positioning. + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + IM_ASSERT(column_index > 0); // We are not supposed to drag column 0. + IM_ASSERT(g.ActiveId == columns->ID + ImGuiID(column_index)); + + float x = g.IO.MousePos.x - g.ActiveIdClickOffset.x + COLUMNS_HIT_RECT_HALF_WIDTH - window->Pos.x; + x = ImMax(x, ImGui::GetColumnOffset(column_index - 1) + g.Style.ColumnsMinSpacing); + if ((columns->Flags & ImGuiOldColumnFlags_NoPreserveWidths)) + x = ImMin(x, ImGui::GetColumnOffset(column_index + 1) - g.Style.ColumnsMinSpacing); + + return x; +} + +float ImGui::GetColumnOffset(int column_index) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead(); + ImGuiOldColumns* columns = window->DC.CurrentColumns; + if (columns == NULL) + return 0.0f; + + if (column_index < 0) + column_index = columns->Current; + IM_ASSERT(column_index < columns->Columns.Size); + + const float t = columns->Columns[column_index].OffsetNorm; + const float x_offset = ImLerp(columns->OffMinX, columns->OffMaxX, t); + return x_offset; +} + +static float GetColumnWidthEx(ImGuiOldColumns* columns, int column_index, bool before_resize = false) +{ + if (column_index < 0) + column_index = columns->Current; + + float offset_norm; + if (before_resize) + offset_norm = columns->Columns[column_index + 1].OffsetNormBeforeResize - columns->Columns[column_index].OffsetNormBeforeResize; + else + offset_norm = columns->Columns[column_index + 1].OffsetNorm - columns->Columns[column_index].OffsetNorm; + return ImGui::GetColumnOffsetFromNorm(columns, offset_norm); +} + +float ImGui::GetColumnWidth(int column_index) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + ImGuiOldColumns* columns = window->DC.CurrentColumns; + if (columns == NULL) + return GetContentRegionAvail().x; + + if (column_index < 0) + column_index = columns->Current; + return GetColumnOffsetFromNorm(columns, columns->Columns[column_index + 1].OffsetNorm - columns->Columns[column_index].OffsetNorm); +} + +void ImGui::SetColumnOffset(int column_index, float offset) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + ImGuiOldColumns* columns = window->DC.CurrentColumns; + IM_ASSERT(columns != NULL); + + if (column_index < 0) + column_index = columns->Current; + IM_ASSERT(column_index < columns->Columns.Size); + + const bool preserve_width = !(columns->Flags & ImGuiOldColumnFlags_NoPreserveWidths) && (column_index < columns->Count - 1); + const float width = preserve_width ? GetColumnWidthEx(columns, column_index, columns->IsBeingResized) : 0.0f; + + if (!(columns->Flags & ImGuiOldColumnFlags_NoForceWithinWindow)) + offset = ImMin(offset, columns->OffMaxX - g.Style.ColumnsMinSpacing * (columns->Count - column_index)); + columns->Columns[column_index].OffsetNorm = GetColumnNormFromOffset(columns, offset - columns->OffMinX); + + if (preserve_width) + SetColumnOffset(column_index + 1, offset + ImMax(g.Style.ColumnsMinSpacing, width)); +} + +void ImGui::SetColumnWidth(int column_index, float width) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead(); + ImGuiOldColumns* columns = window->DC.CurrentColumns; + IM_ASSERT(columns != NULL); + + if (column_index < 0) + column_index = columns->Current; + SetColumnOffset(column_index + 1, GetColumnOffset(column_index) + width); +} + +void ImGui::PushColumnClipRect(int column_index) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead(); + ImGuiOldColumns* columns = window->DC.CurrentColumns; + if (column_index < 0) + column_index = columns->Current; + + ImGuiOldColumnData* column = &columns->Columns[column_index]; + PushClipRect(column->ClipRect.Min, column->ClipRect.Max, false); +} + +// Get into the columns background draw command (which is generally the same draw command as before we called BeginColumns) +void ImGui::PushColumnsBackground() +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead(); + ImGuiOldColumns* columns = window->DC.CurrentColumns; + if (columns->Count == 1) + return; + + // Optimization: avoid SetCurrentChannel() + PushClipRect() + columns->HostBackupClipRect = window->ClipRect; + SetWindowClipRectBeforeSetChannel(window, columns->HostInitialClipRect); + columns->Splitter.SetCurrentChannel(window->DrawList, 0); +} + +void ImGui::PopColumnsBackground() +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead(); + ImGuiOldColumns* columns = window->DC.CurrentColumns; + if (columns->Count == 1) + return; + + // Optimization: avoid PopClipRect() + SetCurrentChannel() + SetWindowClipRectBeforeSetChannel(window, columns->HostBackupClipRect); + columns->Splitter.SetCurrentChannel(window->DrawList, columns->Current + 1); +} + +ImGuiOldColumns* ImGui::FindOrCreateColumns(ImGuiWindow* window, ImGuiID id) +{ + // We have few columns per window so for now we don't need bother much with turning this into a faster lookup. + for (int n = 0; n < window->ColumnsStorage.Size; n++) + if (window->ColumnsStorage[n].ID == id) + return &window->ColumnsStorage[n]; + + window->ColumnsStorage.push_back(ImGuiOldColumns()); + ImGuiOldColumns* columns = &window->ColumnsStorage.back(); + columns->ID = id; + return columns; +} + +ImGuiID ImGui::GetColumnsID(const char* str_id, int columns_count) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + + // Differentiate column ID with an arbitrary prefix for cases where users name their columns set the same as another widget. + // In addition, when an identifier isn't explicitly provided we include the number of columns in the hash to make it uniquer. + PushID(0x11223347 + (str_id ? 0 : columns_count)); + ImGuiID id = window->GetID(str_id ? str_id : "columns"); + PopID(); + + return id; +} + +void ImGui::BeginColumns(const char* str_id, int columns_count, ImGuiOldColumnFlags flags) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + + IM_ASSERT(columns_count >= 1); + IM_ASSERT(window->DC.CurrentColumns == NULL); // Nested columns are currently not supported + + // Acquire storage for the columns set + ImGuiID id = GetColumnsID(str_id, columns_count); + ImGuiOldColumns* columns = FindOrCreateColumns(window, id); + IM_ASSERT(columns->ID == id); + columns->Current = 0; + columns->Count = columns_count; + columns->Flags = flags; + window->DC.CurrentColumns = columns; + + columns->HostCursorPosY = window->DC.CursorPos.y; + columns->HostCursorMaxPosX = window->DC.CursorMaxPos.x; + columns->HostInitialClipRect = window->ClipRect; + columns->HostBackupParentWorkRect = window->ParentWorkRect; + window->ParentWorkRect = window->WorkRect; + + // Set state for first column + // We aim so that the right-most column will have the same clipping width as other after being clipped by parent ClipRect + const float column_padding = g.Style.ItemSpacing.x; + const float half_clip_extend_x = ImFloor(ImMax(window->WindowPadding.x * 0.5f, window->WindowBorderSize)); + const float max_1 = window->WorkRect.Max.x + column_padding - ImMax(column_padding - window->WindowPadding.x, 0.0f); + const float max_2 = window->WorkRect.Max.x + half_clip_extend_x; + columns->OffMinX = window->DC.Indent.x - column_padding + ImMax(column_padding - window->WindowPadding.x, 0.0f); + columns->OffMaxX = ImMax(ImMin(max_1, max_2) - window->Pos.x, columns->OffMinX + 1.0f); + columns->LineMinY = columns->LineMaxY = window->DC.CursorPos.y; + + // Clear data if columns count changed + if (columns->Columns.Size != 0 && columns->Columns.Size != columns_count + 1) + columns->Columns.resize(0); + + // Initialize default widths + columns->IsFirstFrame = (columns->Columns.Size == 0); + if (columns->Columns.Size == 0) + { + columns->Columns.reserve(columns_count + 1); + for (int n = 0; n < columns_count + 1; n++) + { + ImGuiOldColumnData column; + column.OffsetNorm = n / (float)columns_count; + columns->Columns.push_back(column); + } + } + + for (int n = 0; n < columns_count; n++) + { + // Compute clipping rectangle + ImGuiOldColumnData* column = &columns->Columns[n]; + float clip_x1 = IM_ROUND(window->Pos.x + GetColumnOffset(n)); + float clip_x2 = IM_ROUND(window->Pos.x + GetColumnOffset(n + 1) - 1.0f); + column->ClipRect = ImRect(clip_x1, -FLT_MAX, clip_x2, +FLT_MAX); + column->ClipRect.ClipWithFull(window->ClipRect); + } + + if (columns->Count > 1) + { + columns->Splitter.Split(window->DrawList, 1 + columns->Count); + columns->Splitter.SetCurrentChannel(window->DrawList, 1); + PushColumnClipRect(0); + } + + // We don't generally store Indent.x inside ColumnsOffset because it may be manipulated by the user. + float offset_0 = GetColumnOffset(columns->Current); + float offset_1 = GetColumnOffset(columns->Current + 1); + float width = offset_1 - offset_0; + PushItemWidth(width * 0.65f); + window->DC.ColumnsOffset.x = ImMax(column_padding - window->WindowPadding.x, 0.0f); + window->DC.CursorPos.x = IM_FLOOR(window->Pos.x + window->DC.Indent.x + window->DC.ColumnsOffset.x); + window->WorkRect.Max.x = window->Pos.x + offset_1 - column_padding; +} + +void ImGui::NextColumn() +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + if (window->SkipItems || window->DC.CurrentColumns == NULL) + return; + + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiOldColumns* columns = window->DC.CurrentColumns; + + if (columns->Count == 1) + { + window->DC.CursorPos.x = IM_FLOOR(window->Pos.x + window->DC.Indent.x + window->DC.ColumnsOffset.x); + IM_ASSERT(columns->Current == 0); + return; + } + + // Next column + if (++columns->Current == columns->Count) + columns->Current = 0; + + PopItemWidth(); + + // Optimization: avoid PopClipRect() + SetCurrentChannel() + PushClipRect() + // (which would needlessly attempt to update commands in the wrong channel, then pop or overwrite them), + ImGuiOldColumnData* column = &columns->Columns[columns->Current]; + SetWindowClipRectBeforeSetChannel(window, column->ClipRect); + columns->Splitter.SetCurrentChannel(window->DrawList, columns->Current + 1); + + const float column_padding = g.Style.ItemSpacing.x; + columns->LineMaxY = ImMax(columns->LineMaxY, window->DC.CursorPos.y); + if (columns->Current > 0) + { + // Columns 1+ ignore IndentX (by canceling it out) + // FIXME-COLUMNS: Unnecessary, could be locked? + window->DC.ColumnsOffset.x = GetColumnOffset(columns->Current) - window->DC.Indent.x + column_padding; + } + else + { + // New row/line: column 0 honor IndentX. + window->DC.ColumnsOffset.x = ImMax(column_padding - window->WindowPadding.x, 0.0f); + columns->LineMinY = columns->LineMaxY; + } + window->DC.CursorPos.x = IM_FLOOR(window->Pos.x + window->DC.Indent.x + window->DC.ColumnsOffset.x); + window->DC.CursorPos.y = columns->LineMinY; + window->DC.CurrLineSize = ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f); + window->DC.CurrLineTextBaseOffset = 0.0f; + + // FIXME-COLUMNS: Share code with BeginColumns() - move code on columns setup. + float offset_0 = GetColumnOffset(columns->Current); + float offset_1 = GetColumnOffset(columns->Current + 1); + float width = offset_1 - offset_0; + PushItemWidth(width * 0.65f); + window->WorkRect.Max.x = window->Pos.x + offset_1 - column_padding; +} + +void ImGui::EndColumns() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + ImGuiOldColumns* columns = window->DC.CurrentColumns; + IM_ASSERT(columns != NULL); + + PopItemWidth(); + if (columns->Count > 1) + { + PopClipRect(); + columns->Splitter.Merge(window->DrawList); + } + + const ImGuiOldColumnFlags flags = columns->Flags; + columns->LineMaxY = ImMax(columns->LineMaxY, window->DC.CursorPos.y); + window->DC.CursorPos.y = columns->LineMaxY; + if (!(flags & ImGuiOldColumnFlags_GrowParentContentsSize)) + window->DC.CursorMaxPos.x = columns->HostCursorMaxPosX; // Restore cursor max pos, as columns don't grow parent + + // Draw columns borders and handle resize + // The IsBeingResized flag ensure we preserve pre-resize columns width so back-and-forth are not lossy + bool is_being_resized = false; + if (!(flags & ImGuiOldColumnFlags_NoBorder) && !window->SkipItems) + { + // We clip Y boundaries CPU side because very long triangles are mishandled by some GPU drivers. + const float y1 = ImMax(columns->HostCursorPosY, window->ClipRect.Min.y); + const float y2 = ImMin(window->DC.CursorPos.y, window->ClipRect.Max.y); + int dragging_column = -1; + for (int n = 1; n < columns->Count; n++) + { + ImGuiOldColumnData* column = &columns->Columns[n]; + float x = window->Pos.x + GetColumnOffset(n); + const ImGuiID column_id = columns->ID + ImGuiID(n); + const float column_hit_hw = COLUMNS_HIT_RECT_HALF_WIDTH; + const ImRect column_hit_rect(ImVec2(x - column_hit_hw, y1), ImVec2(x + column_hit_hw, y2)); + KeepAliveID(column_id); + if (IsClippedEx(column_hit_rect, column_id, false)) + continue; + + bool hovered = false, held = false; + if (!(flags & ImGuiOldColumnFlags_NoResize)) + { + ButtonBehavior(column_hit_rect, column_id, &hovered, &held); + if (hovered || held) + g.MouseCursor = ImGuiMouseCursor_ResizeEW; + if (held && !(column->Flags & ImGuiOldColumnFlags_NoResize)) + dragging_column = n; + } + + // Draw column + const ImU32 col = GetColorU32(held ? ImGuiCol_SeparatorActive : hovered ? ImGuiCol_SeparatorHovered : ImGuiCol_Separator); + const float xi = IM_FLOOR(x); + window->DrawList->AddLine(ImVec2(xi, y1 + 1.0f), ImVec2(xi, y2), col); + } + + // Apply dragging after drawing the column lines, so our rendered lines are in sync with how items were displayed during the frame. + if (dragging_column != -1) + { + if (!columns->IsBeingResized) + for (int n = 0; n < columns->Count + 1; n++) + columns->Columns[n].OffsetNormBeforeResize = columns->Columns[n].OffsetNorm; + columns->IsBeingResized = is_being_resized = true; + float x = GetDraggedColumnOffset(columns, dragging_column); + SetColumnOffset(dragging_column, x); + } + } + columns->IsBeingResized = is_being_resized; + + window->WorkRect = window->ParentWorkRect; + window->ParentWorkRect = columns->HostBackupParentWorkRect; + window->DC.CurrentColumns = NULL; + window->DC.ColumnsOffset.x = 0.0f; + window->DC.CursorPos.x = IM_FLOOR(window->Pos.x + window->DC.Indent.x + window->DC.ColumnsOffset.x); +} + +void ImGui::Columns(int columns_count, const char* id, bool border) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + IM_ASSERT(columns_count >= 1); + + ImGuiOldColumnFlags flags = (border ? 0 : ImGuiOldColumnFlags_NoBorder); + //flags |= ImGuiOldColumnFlags_NoPreserveWidths; // NB: Legacy behavior + ImGuiOldColumns* columns = window->DC.CurrentColumns; + if (columns != NULL && columns->Count == columns_count && columns->Flags == flags) + return; + + if (columns != NULL) + EndColumns(); + + if (columns_count != 1) + BeginColumns(id, columns_count, flags); +} + +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +#endif // #ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE diff --git a/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/imgui-1.84.2/imgui_widgets.cpp b/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/imgui-1.84.2/imgui_widgets.cpp new file mode 100644 index 0000000..e3ac15f --- /dev/null +++ b/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/imgui-1.84.2/imgui_widgets.cpp @@ -0,0 +1,8195 @@ +// dear imgui, v1.84 +// (widgets code) + +/* + +Index of this file: + +// [SECTION] Forward Declarations +// [SECTION] Widgets: Text, etc. +// [SECTION] Widgets: Main (Button, Image, Checkbox, RadioButton, ProgressBar, Bullet, etc.) +// [SECTION] Widgets: Low-level Layout helpers (Spacing, Dummy, NewLine, Separator, etc.) +// [SECTION] Widgets: ComboBox +// [SECTION] Data Type and Data Formatting Helpers +// [SECTION] Widgets: DragScalar, DragFloat, DragInt, etc. +// [SECTION] Widgets: SliderScalar, SliderFloat, SliderInt, etc. +// [SECTION] Widgets: InputScalar, InputFloat, InputInt, etc. +// [SECTION] Widgets: InputText, InputTextMultiline +// [SECTION] Widgets: ColorEdit, ColorPicker, ColorButton, etc. +// [SECTION] Widgets: TreeNode, CollapsingHeader, etc. +// [SECTION] Widgets: Selectable +// [SECTION] Widgets: ListBox +// [SECTION] Widgets: PlotLines, PlotHistogram +// [SECTION] Widgets: Value helpers +// [SECTION] Widgets: MenuItem, BeginMenu, EndMenu, etc. +// [SECTION] Widgets: BeginTabBar, EndTabBar, etc. +// [SECTION] Widgets: BeginTabItem, EndTabItem, etc. +// [SECTION] Widgets: Columns, BeginColumns, EndColumns, etc. + +*/ + +#if defined(_MSC_VER) && !defined(_CRT_SECURE_NO_WARNINGS) +#define _CRT_SECURE_NO_WARNINGS +#endif + +#include "imgui.h" +#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE + +#ifndef IMGUI_DEFINE_MATH_OPERATORS +#define IMGUI_DEFINE_MATH_OPERATORS +#endif +#include "imgui_internal.h" + +// System includes +#include // toupper +#if defined(_MSC_VER) && _MSC_VER <= 1500 // MSVC 2008 or earlier +#include // intptr_t +#else +#include // intptr_t +#endif + +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// Warnings +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// Visual Studio warnings +#ifdef _MSC_VER +#pragma warning (disable: 4127) // condition expression is constant +#pragma warning (disable: 4996) // 'This function or variable may be unsafe': strcpy, strdup, sprintf, vsnprintf, sscanf, fopen +#if defined(_MSC_VER) && _MSC_VER >= 1922 // MSVC 2019 16.2 or later +#pragma warning (disable: 5054) // operator '|': deprecated between enumerations of different types +#endif +#pragma warning (disable: 26451) // [Static Analyzer] Arithmetic overflow : Using operator 'xxx' on a 4 byte value and then casting the result to a 8 byte value. Cast the value to the wider type before calling operator 'xxx' to avoid overflow(io.2). +#pragma warning (disable: 26812) // [Static Analyzer] The enum type 'xxx' is unscoped. Prefer 'enum class' over 'enum' (Enum.3). +#endif + +// Clang/GCC warnings with -Weverything +#if defined(__clang__) +#if __has_warning("-Wunknown-warning-option") +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wunknown-warning-option" // warning: unknown warning group 'xxx' // not all warnings are known by all Clang versions and they tend to be rename-happy.. so ignoring warnings triggers new warnings on some configuration. Great! +#endif +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wunknown-pragmas" // warning: unknown warning group 'xxx' +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wold-style-cast" // warning: use of old-style cast // yes, they are more terse. +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wfloat-equal" // warning: comparing floating point with == or != is unsafe // storing and comparing against same constants (typically 0.0f) is ok. +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wformat-nonliteral" // warning: format string is not a string literal // passing non-literal to vsnformat(). yes, user passing incorrect format strings can crash the code. +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wsign-conversion" // warning: implicit conversion changes signedness +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wzero-as-null-pointer-constant" // warning: zero as null pointer constant // some standard header variations use #define NULL 0 +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wdouble-promotion" // warning: implicit conversion from 'float' to 'double' when passing argument to function // using printf() is a misery with this as C++ va_arg ellipsis changes float to double. +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wenum-enum-conversion" // warning: bitwise operation between different enumeration types ('XXXFlags_' and 'XXXFlagsPrivate_') +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wdeprecated-enum-enum-conversion"// warning: bitwise operation between different enumeration types ('XXXFlags_' and 'XXXFlagsPrivate_') is deprecated +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wimplicit-int-float-conversion" // warning: implicit conversion from 'xxx' to 'float' may lose precision +#elif defined(__GNUC__) +#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wpragmas" // warning: unknown option after '#pragma GCC diagnostic' kind +#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wformat-nonliteral" // warning: format not a string literal, format string not checked +#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wclass-memaccess" // [__GNUC__ >= 8] warning: 'memset/memcpy' clearing/writing an object of type 'xxxx' with no trivial copy-assignment; use assignment or value-initialization instead +#endif + +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// Data +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// Widgets +static const float DRAGDROP_HOLD_TO_OPEN_TIMER = 0.70f; // Time for drag-hold to activate items accepting the ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnDragDropHold button behavior. +static const float DRAG_MOUSE_THRESHOLD_FACTOR = 0.50f; // Multiplier for the default value of io.MouseDragThreshold to make DragFloat/DragInt react faster to mouse drags. + +// Those MIN/MAX values are not define because we need to point to them +static const signed char IM_S8_MIN = -128; +static const signed char IM_S8_MAX = 127; +static const unsigned char IM_U8_MIN = 0; +static const unsigned char IM_U8_MAX = 0xFF; +static const signed short IM_S16_MIN = -32768; +static const signed short IM_S16_MAX = 32767; +static const unsigned short IM_U16_MIN = 0; +static const unsigned short IM_U16_MAX = 0xFFFF; +static const ImS32 IM_S32_MIN = INT_MIN; // (-2147483647 - 1), (0x80000000); +static const ImS32 IM_S32_MAX = INT_MAX; // (2147483647), (0x7FFFFFFF) +static const ImU32 IM_U32_MIN = 0; +static const ImU32 IM_U32_MAX = UINT_MAX; // (0xFFFFFFFF) +#ifdef LLONG_MIN +static const ImS64 IM_S64_MIN = LLONG_MIN; // (-9223372036854775807ll - 1ll); +static const ImS64 IM_S64_MAX = LLONG_MAX; // (9223372036854775807ll); +#else +static const ImS64 IM_S64_MIN = -9223372036854775807LL - 1; +static const ImS64 IM_S64_MAX = 9223372036854775807LL; +#endif +static const ImU64 IM_U64_MIN = 0; +#ifdef ULLONG_MAX +static const ImU64 IM_U64_MAX = ULLONG_MAX; // (0xFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFull); +#else +static const ImU64 IM_U64_MAX = (2ULL * 9223372036854775807LL + 1); +#endif + +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Forward Declarations +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// For InputTextEx() +static bool InputTextFilterCharacter(unsigned int* p_char, ImGuiInputTextFlags flags, ImGuiInputTextCallback callback, void* user_data, ImGuiInputSource input_source); +static int InputTextCalcTextLenAndLineCount(const char* text_begin, const char** out_text_end); +static ImVec2 InputTextCalcTextSizeW(const ImWchar* text_begin, const ImWchar* text_end, const ImWchar** remaining = NULL, ImVec2* out_offset = NULL, bool stop_on_new_line = false); + +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Widgets: Text, etc. +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// - TextEx() [Internal] +// - TextUnformatted() +// - Text() +// - TextV() +// - TextColored() +// - TextColoredV() +// - TextDisabled() +// - TextDisabledV() +// - TextWrapped() +// - TextWrappedV() +// - LabelText() +// - LabelTextV() +// - BulletText() +// - BulletTextV() +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +void ImGui::TextEx(const char* text, const char* text_end, ImGuiTextFlags flags) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + if (window->SkipItems) + return; + + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + IM_ASSERT(text != NULL); + const char* text_begin = text; + if (text_end == NULL) + text_end = text + strlen(text); // FIXME-OPT + + const ImVec2 text_pos(window->DC.CursorPos.x, window->DC.CursorPos.y + window->DC.CurrLineTextBaseOffset); + const float wrap_pos_x = window->DC.TextWrapPos; + const bool wrap_enabled = (wrap_pos_x >= 0.0f); + if (text_end - text > 2000 && !wrap_enabled) + { + // Long text! + // Perform manual coarse clipping to optimize for long multi-line text + // - From this point we will only compute the width of lines that are visible. Optimization only available when word-wrapping is disabled. + // - We also don't vertically center the text within the line full height, which is unlikely to matter because we are likely the biggest and only item on the line. + // - We use memchr(), pay attention that well optimized versions of those str/mem functions are much faster than a casually written loop. + const char* line = text; + const float line_height = GetTextLineHeight(); + ImVec2 text_size(0, 0); + + // Lines to skip (can't skip when logging text) + ImVec2 pos = text_pos; + if (!g.LogEnabled) + { + int lines_skippable = (int)((window->ClipRect.Min.y - text_pos.y) / line_height); + if (lines_skippable > 0) + { + int lines_skipped = 0; + while (line < text_end && lines_skipped < lines_skippable) + { + const char* line_end = (const char*)memchr(line, '\n', text_end - line); + if (!line_end) + line_end = text_end; + if ((flags & ImGuiTextFlags_NoWidthForLargeClippedText) == 0) + text_size.x = ImMax(text_size.x, CalcTextSize(line, line_end).x); + line = line_end + 1; + lines_skipped++; + } + pos.y += lines_skipped * line_height; + } + } + + // Lines to render + if (line < text_end) + { + ImRect line_rect(pos, pos + ImVec2(FLT_MAX, line_height)); + while (line < text_end) + { + if (IsClippedEx(line_rect, 0, false)) + break; + + const char* line_end = (const char*)memchr(line, '\n', text_end - line); + if (!line_end) + line_end = text_end; + text_size.x = ImMax(text_size.x, CalcTextSize(line, line_end).x); + RenderText(pos, line, line_end, false); + line = line_end + 1; + line_rect.Min.y += line_height; + line_rect.Max.y += line_height; + pos.y += line_height; + } + + // Count remaining lines + int lines_skipped = 0; + while (line < text_end) + { + const char* line_end = (const char*)memchr(line, '\n', text_end - line); + if (!line_end) + line_end = text_end; + if ((flags & ImGuiTextFlags_NoWidthForLargeClippedText) == 0) + text_size.x = ImMax(text_size.x, CalcTextSize(line, line_end).x); + line = line_end + 1; + lines_skipped++; + } + pos.y += lines_skipped * line_height; + } + text_size.y = (pos - text_pos).y; + + ImRect bb(text_pos, text_pos + text_size); + ItemSize(text_size, 0.0f); + ItemAdd(bb, 0); + } + else + { + const float wrap_width = wrap_enabled ? CalcWrapWidthForPos(window->DC.CursorPos, wrap_pos_x) : 0.0f; + const ImVec2 text_size = CalcTextSize(text_begin, text_end, false, wrap_width); + + ImRect bb(text_pos, text_pos + text_size); + ItemSize(text_size, 0.0f); + if (!ItemAdd(bb, 0)) + return; + + // Render (we don't hide text after ## in this end-user function) + RenderTextWrapped(bb.Min, text_begin, text_end, wrap_width); + } +} + +void ImGui::TextUnformatted(const char* text, const char* text_end) +{ + TextEx(text, text_end, ImGuiTextFlags_NoWidthForLargeClippedText); +} + +void ImGui::Text(const char* fmt, ...) +{ + va_list args; + va_start(args, fmt); + TextV(fmt, args); + va_end(args); +} + +void ImGui::TextV(const char* fmt, va_list args) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + if (window->SkipItems) + return; + + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + const char* text_end = g.TempBuffer + ImFormatStringV(g.TempBuffer, IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.TempBuffer), fmt, args); + TextEx(g.TempBuffer, text_end, ImGuiTextFlags_NoWidthForLargeClippedText); +} + +void ImGui::TextColored(const ImVec4& col, const char* fmt, ...) +{ + va_list args; + va_start(args, fmt); + TextColoredV(col, fmt, args); + va_end(args); +} + +void ImGui::TextColoredV(const ImVec4& col, const char* fmt, va_list args) +{ + PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_Text, col); + if (fmt[0] == '%' && fmt[1] == 's' && fmt[2] == 0) + TextEx(va_arg(args, const char*), NULL, ImGuiTextFlags_NoWidthForLargeClippedText); // Skip formatting + else + TextV(fmt, args); + PopStyleColor(); +} + +void ImGui::TextDisabled(const char* fmt, ...) +{ + va_list args; + va_start(args, fmt); + TextDisabledV(fmt, args); + va_end(args); +} + +void ImGui::TextDisabledV(const char* fmt, va_list args) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_Text, g.Style.Colors[ImGuiCol_TextDisabled]); + if (fmt[0] == '%' && fmt[1] == 's' && fmt[2] == 0) + TextEx(va_arg(args, const char*), NULL, ImGuiTextFlags_NoWidthForLargeClippedText); // Skip formatting + else + TextV(fmt, args); + PopStyleColor(); +} + +void ImGui::TextWrapped(const char* fmt, ...) +{ + va_list args; + va_start(args, fmt); + TextWrappedV(fmt, args); + va_end(args); +} + +void ImGui::TextWrappedV(const char* fmt, va_list args) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + bool need_backup = (g.CurrentWindow->DC.TextWrapPos < 0.0f); // Keep existing wrap position if one is already set + if (need_backup) + PushTextWrapPos(0.0f); + if (fmt[0] == '%' && fmt[1] == 's' && fmt[2] == 0) + TextEx(va_arg(args, const char*), NULL, ImGuiTextFlags_NoWidthForLargeClippedText); // Skip formatting + else + TextV(fmt, args); + if (need_backup) + PopTextWrapPos(); +} + +void ImGui::LabelText(const char* label, const char* fmt, ...) +{ + va_list args; + va_start(args, fmt); + LabelTextV(label, fmt, args); + va_end(args); +} + +// Add a label+text combo aligned to other label+value widgets +void ImGui::LabelTextV(const char* label, const char* fmt, va_list args) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + if (window->SkipItems) + return; + + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style; + const float w = CalcItemWidth(); + + const char* value_text_begin = &g.TempBuffer[0]; + const char* value_text_end = value_text_begin + ImFormatStringV(g.TempBuffer, IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.TempBuffer), fmt, args); + const ImVec2 value_size = CalcTextSize(value_text_begin, value_text_end, false); + const ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true); + + const ImVec2 pos = window->DC.CursorPos; + const ImRect value_bb(pos, pos + ImVec2(w, value_size.y + style.FramePadding.y * 2)); + const ImRect total_bb(pos, pos + ImVec2(w + (label_size.x > 0.0f ? style.ItemInnerSpacing.x + label_size.x : 0.0f), ImMax(value_size.y, label_size.y) + style.FramePadding.y * 2)); + ItemSize(total_bb, style.FramePadding.y); + if (!ItemAdd(total_bb, 0)) + return; + + // Render + RenderTextClipped(value_bb.Min + style.FramePadding, value_bb.Max, value_text_begin, value_text_end, &value_size, ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f)); + if (label_size.x > 0.0f) + RenderText(ImVec2(value_bb.Max.x + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x, value_bb.Min.y + style.FramePadding.y), label); +} + +void ImGui::BulletText(const char* fmt, ...) +{ + va_list args; + va_start(args, fmt); + BulletTextV(fmt, args); + va_end(args); +} + +// Text with a little bullet aligned to the typical tree node. +void ImGui::BulletTextV(const char* fmt, va_list args) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + if (window->SkipItems) + return; + + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style; + + const char* text_begin = g.TempBuffer; + const char* text_end = text_begin + ImFormatStringV(g.TempBuffer, IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.TempBuffer), fmt, args); + const ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(text_begin, text_end, false); + const ImVec2 total_size = ImVec2(g.FontSize + (label_size.x > 0.0f ? (label_size.x + style.FramePadding.x * 2) : 0.0f), label_size.y); // Empty text doesn't add padding + ImVec2 pos = window->DC.CursorPos; + pos.y += window->DC.CurrLineTextBaseOffset; + ItemSize(total_size, 0.0f); + const ImRect bb(pos, pos + total_size); + if (!ItemAdd(bb, 0)) + return; + + // Render + ImU32 text_col = GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text); + RenderBullet(window->DrawList, bb.Min + ImVec2(style.FramePadding.x + g.FontSize * 0.5f, g.FontSize * 0.5f), text_col); + RenderText(bb.Min + ImVec2(g.FontSize + style.FramePadding.x * 2, 0.0f), text_begin, text_end, false); +} + +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Widgets: Main +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// - ButtonBehavior() [Internal] +// - Button() +// - SmallButton() +// - InvisibleButton() +// - ArrowButton() +// - CloseButton() [Internal] +// - CollapseButton() [Internal] +// - GetWindowScrollbarID() [Internal] +// - GetWindowScrollbarRect() [Internal] +// - Scrollbar() [Internal] +// - ScrollbarEx() [Internal] +// - Image() +// - ImageButton() +// - Checkbox() +// - CheckboxFlagsT() [Internal] +// - CheckboxFlags() +// - RadioButton() +// - ProgressBar() +// - Bullet() +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// The ButtonBehavior() function is key to many interactions and used by many/most widgets. +// Because we handle so many cases (keyboard/gamepad navigation, drag and drop) and many specific behavior (via ImGuiButtonFlags_), +// this code is a little complex. +// By far the most common path is interacting with the Mouse using the default ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClickRelease button behavior. +// See the series of events below and the corresponding state reported by dear imgui: +//------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +// with PressedOnClickRelease: return-value IsItemHovered() IsItemActive() IsItemActivated() IsItemDeactivated() IsItemClicked() +// Frame N+0 (mouse is outside bb) - - - - - - +// Frame N+1 (mouse moves inside bb) - true - - - - +// Frame N+2 (mouse button is down) - true true true - true +// Frame N+3 (mouse button is down) - true true - - - +// Frame N+4 (mouse moves outside bb) - - true - - - +// Frame N+5 (mouse moves inside bb) - true true - - - +// Frame N+6 (mouse button is released) true true - - true - +// Frame N+7 (mouse button is released) - true - - - - +// Frame N+8 (mouse moves outside bb) - - - - - - +//------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +// with PressedOnClick: return-value IsItemHovered() IsItemActive() IsItemActivated() IsItemDeactivated() IsItemClicked() +// Frame N+2 (mouse button is down) true true true true - true +// Frame N+3 (mouse button is down) - true true - - - +// Frame N+6 (mouse button is released) - true - - true - +// Frame N+7 (mouse button is released) - true - - - - +//------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +// with PressedOnRelease: return-value IsItemHovered() IsItemActive() IsItemActivated() IsItemDeactivated() IsItemClicked() +// Frame N+2 (mouse button is down) - true - - - true +// Frame N+3 (mouse button is down) - true - - - - +// Frame N+6 (mouse button is released) true true - - - - +// Frame N+7 (mouse button is released) - true - - - - +//------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +// with PressedOnDoubleClick: return-value IsItemHovered() IsItemActive() IsItemActivated() IsItemDeactivated() IsItemClicked() +// Frame N+0 (mouse button is down) - true - - - true +// Frame N+1 (mouse button is down) - true - - - - +// Frame N+2 (mouse button is released) - true - - - - +// Frame N+3 (mouse button is released) - true - - - - +// Frame N+4 (mouse button is down) true true true true - true +// Frame N+5 (mouse button is down) - true true - - - +// Frame N+6 (mouse button is released) - true - - true - +// Frame N+7 (mouse button is released) - true - - - - +//------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +// Note that some combinations are supported, +// - PressedOnDragDropHold can generally be associated with any flag. +// - PressedOnDoubleClick can be associated by PressedOnClickRelease/PressedOnRelease, in which case the second release event won't be reported. +//------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +// The behavior of the return-value changes when ImGuiButtonFlags_Repeat is set: +// Repeat+ Repeat+ Repeat+ Repeat+ +// PressedOnClickRelease PressedOnClick PressedOnRelease PressedOnDoubleClick +//------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// Frame N+0 (mouse button is down) - true - true +// ... - - - - +// Frame N + RepeatDelay true true - true +// ... - - - - +// Frame N + RepeatDelay + RepeatRate*N true true - true +//------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +bool ImGui::ButtonBehavior(const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id, bool* out_hovered, bool* out_held, ImGuiButtonFlags flags) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + + // Default only reacts to left mouse button + if ((flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_MouseButtonMask_) == 0) + flags |= ImGuiButtonFlags_MouseButtonDefault_; + + // Default behavior requires click + release inside bounding box + if ((flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnMask_) == 0) + flags |= ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnDefault_; + + ImGuiWindow* backup_hovered_window = g.HoveredWindow; + const bool flatten_hovered_children = (flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_FlattenChildren) && g.HoveredWindow && g.HoveredWindow->RootWindow == window; + if (flatten_hovered_children) + g.HoveredWindow = window; + +#ifdef IMGUI_ENABLE_TEST_ENGINE + if (id != 0 && g.LastItemData.ID != id) + IMGUI_TEST_ENGINE_ITEM_ADD(bb, id); +#endif + + bool pressed = false; + bool hovered = ItemHoverable(bb, id); + + // Drag source doesn't report as hovered + if (hovered && g.DragDropActive && g.DragDropPayload.SourceId == id && !(g.DragDropSourceFlags & ImGuiDragDropFlags_SourceNoDisableHover)) + hovered = false; + + // Special mode for Drag and Drop where holding button pressed for a long time while dragging another item triggers the button + if (g.DragDropActive && (flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnDragDropHold) && !(g.DragDropSourceFlags & ImGuiDragDropFlags_SourceNoHoldToOpenOthers)) + if (IsItemHovered(ImGuiHoveredFlags_AllowWhenBlockedByActiveItem)) + { + hovered = true; + SetHoveredID(id); + if (g.HoveredIdTimer - g.IO.DeltaTime <= DRAGDROP_HOLD_TO_OPEN_TIMER && g.HoveredIdTimer >= DRAGDROP_HOLD_TO_OPEN_TIMER) + { + pressed = true; + g.DragDropHoldJustPressedId = id; + FocusWindow(window); + } + } + + if (flatten_hovered_children) + g.HoveredWindow = backup_hovered_window; + + // AllowOverlap mode (rarely used) requires previous frame HoveredId to be null or to match. This allows using patterns where a later submitted widget overlaps a previous one. + if (hovered && (flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_AllowItemOverlap) && (g.HoveredIdPreviousFrame != id && g.HoveredIdPreviousFrame != 0)) + hovered = false; + + // Mouse handling + if (hovered) + { + if (!(flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_NoKeyModifiers) || (!g.IO.KeyCtrl && !g.IO.KeyShift && !g.IO.KeyAlt)) + { + // Poll buttons + int mouse_button_clicked = -1; + int mouse_button_released = -1; + if ((flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_MouseButtonLeft) && g.IO.MouseClicked[0]) { mouse_button_clicked = 0; } + else if ((flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_MouseButtonRight) && g.IO.MouseClicked[1]) { mouse_button_clicked = 1; } + else if ((flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_MouseButtonMiddle) && g.IO.MouseClicked[2]) { mouse_button_clicked = 2; } + if ((flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_MouseButtonLeft) && g.IO.MouseReleased[0]) { mouse_button_released = 0; } + else if ((flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_MouseButtonRight) && g.IO.MouseReleased[1]) { mouse_button_released = 1; } + else if ((flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_MouseButtonMiddle) && g.IO.MouseReleased[2]) { mouse_button_released = 2; } + + if (mouse_button_clicked != -1 && g.ActiveId != id) + { + if (flags & (ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClickRelease | ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClickReleaseAnywhere)) + { + SetActiveID(id, window); + g.ActiveIdMouseButton = mouse_button_clicked; + if (!(flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_NoNavFocus)) + SetFocusID(id, window); + FocusWindow(window); + } + if ((flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClick) || ((flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnDoubleClick) && g.IO.MouseDoubleClicked[mouse_button_clicked])) + { + pressed = true; + if (flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_NoHoldingActiveId) + ClearActiveID(); + else + SetActiveID(id, window); // Hold on ID + g.ActiveIdMouseButton = mouse_button_clicked; + FocusWindow(window); + } + } + if ((flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnRelease) && mouse_button_released != -1) + { + // Repeat mode trumps on release behavior + const bool has_repeated_at_least_once = (flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_Repeat) && g.IO.MouseDownDurationPrev[mouse_button_released] >= g.IO.KeyRepeatDelay; + if (!has_repeated_at_least_once) + pressed = true; + ClearActiveID(); + } + + // 'Repeat' mode acts when held regardless of _PressedOn flags (see table above). + // Relies on repeat logic of IsMouseClicked() but we may as well do it ourselves if we end up exposing finer RepeatDelay/RepeatRate settings. + if (g.ActiveId == id && (flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_Repeat)) + if (g.IO.MouseDownDuration[g.ActiveIdMouseButton] > 0.0f && IsMouseClicked(g.ActiveIdMouseButton, true)) + pressed = true; + } + + if (pressed) + g.NavDisableHighlight = true; + } + + // Gamepad/Keyboard navigation + // We report navigated item as hovered but we don't set g.HoveredId to not interfere with mouse. + if (g.NavId == id && !g.NavDisableHighlight && g.NavDisableMouseHover && (g.ActiveId == 0 || g.ActiveId == id || g.ActiveId == window->MoveId)) + if (!(flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_NoHoveredOnFocus)) + hovered = true; + if (g.NavActivateDownId == id) + { + bool nav_activated_by_code = (g.NavActivateId == id); + bool nav_activated_by_inputs = IsNavInputTest(ImGuiNavInput_Activate, (flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_Repeat) ? ImGuiInputReadMode_Repeat : ImGuiInputReadMode_Pressed); + if (nav_activated_by_code || nav_activated_by_inputs) + pressed = true; + if (nav_activated_by_code || nav_activated_by_inputs || g.ActiveId == id) + { + // Set active id so it can be queried by user via IsItemActive(), equivalent of holding the mouse button. + g.NavActivateId = id; // This is so SetActiveId assign a Nav source + SetActiveID(id, window); + if ((nav_activated_by_code || nav_activated_by_inputs) && !(flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_NoNavFocus)) + SetFocusID(id, window); + } + } + + // Process while held + bool held = false; + if (g.ActiveId == id) + { + if (g.ActiveIdSource == ImGuiInputSource_Mouse) + { + if (g.ActiveIdIsJustActivated) + g.ActiveIdClickOffset = g.IO.MousePos - bb.Min; + + const int mouse_button = g.ActiveIdMouseButton; + IM_ASSERT(mouse_button >= 0 && mouse_button < ImGuiMouseButton_COUNT); + if (g.IO.MouseDown[mouse_button]) + { + held = true; + } + else + { + bool release_in = hovered && (flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClickRelease) != 0; + bool release_anywhere = (flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClickReleaseAnywhere) != 0; + if ((release_in || release_anywhere) && !g.DragDropActive) + { + // Report as pressed when releasing the mouse (this is the most common path) + bool is_double_click_release = (flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnDoubleClick) && g.IO.MouseDownWasDoubleClick[mouse_button]; + bool is_repeating_already = (flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_Repeat) && g.IO.MouseDownDurationPrev[mouse_button] >= g.IO.KeyRepeatDelay; // Repeat mode trumps + if (!is_double_click_release && !is_repeating_already) + pressed = true; + } + ClearActiveID(); + } + if (!(flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_NoNavFocus)) + g.NavDisableHighlight = true; + } + else if (g.ActiveIdSource == ImGuiInputSource_Nav) + { + // When activated using Nav, we hold on the ActiveID until activation button is released + if (g.NavActivateDownId != id) + ClearActiveID(); + } + if (pressed) + g.ActiveIdHasBeenPressedBefore = true; + } + + if (out_hovered) *out_hovered = hovered; + if (out_held) *out_held = held; + + return pressed; +} + +bool ImGui::ButtonEx(const char* label, const ImVec2& size_arg, ImGuiButtonFlags flags) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + if (window->SkipItems) + return false; + + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style; + const ImGuiID id = window->GetID(label); + const ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true); + + ImVec2 pos = window->DC.CursorPos; + if ((flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_AlignTextBaseLine) && style.FramePadding.y < window->DC.CurrLineTextBaseOffset) // Try to vertically align buttons that are smaller/have no padding so that text baseline matches (bit hacky, since it shouldn't be a flag) + pos.y += window->DC.CurrLineTextBaseOffset - style.FramePadding.y; + ImVec2 size = CalcItemSize(size_arg, label_size.x + style.FramePadding.x * 2.0f, label_size.y + style.FramePadding.y * 2.0f); + + const ImRect bb(pos, pos + size); + ItemSize(size, style.FramePadding.y); + if (!ItemAdd(bb, id)) + return false; + + if (g.LastItemData.InFlags & ImGuiItemFlags_ButtonRepeat) + flags |= ImGuiButtonFlags_Repeat; + + bool hovered, held; + bool pressed = ButtonBehavior(bb, id, &hovered, &held, flags); + + // Render + const ImU32 col = GetColorU32((held && hovered) ? ImGuiCol_ButtonActive : hovered ? ImGuiCol_ButtonHovered : ImGuiCol_Button); + RenderNavHighlight(bb, id); + RenderFrame(bb.Min, bb.Max, col, true, style.FrameRounding); + + if (g.LogEnabled) + LogSetNextTextDecoration("[", "]"); + RenderTextClipped(bb.Min + style.FramePadding, bb.Max - style.FramePadding, label, NULL, &label_size, style.ButtonTextAlign, &bb); + + // Automatically close popups + //if (pressed && !(flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_DontClosePopups) && (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup)) + // CloseCurrentPopup(); + + IMGUI_TEST_ENGINE_ITEM_INFO(id, label, g.LastItemData.StatusFlags); + return pressed; +} + +bool ImGui::Button(const char* label, const ImVec2& size_arg) +{ + return ButtonEx(label, size_arg, ImGuiButtonFlags_None); +} + +// Small buttons fits within text without additional vertical spacing. +bool ImGui::SmallButton(const char* label) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + float backup_padding_y = g.Style.FramePadding.y; + g.Style.FramePadding.y = 0.0f; + bool pressed = ButtonEx(label, ImVec2(0, 0), ImGuiButtonFlags_AlignTextBaseLine); + g.Style.FramePadding.y = backup_padding_y; + return pressed; +} + +// Tip: use ImGui::PushID()/PopID() to push indices or pointers in the ID stack. +// Then you can keep 'str_id' empty or the same for all your buttons (instead of creating a string based on a non-string id) +bool ImGui::InvisibleButton(const char* str_id, const ImVec2& size_arg, ImGuiButtonFlags flags) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + if (window->SkipItems) + return false; + + // Cannot use zero-size for InvisibleButton(). Unlike Button() there is not way to fallback using the label size. + IM_ASSERT(size_arg.x != 0.0f && size_arg.y != 0.0f); + + const ImGuiID id = window->GetID(str_id); + ImVec2 size = CalcItemSize(size_arg, 0.0f, 0.0f); + const ImRect bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + size); + ItemSize(size); + if (!ItemAdd(bb, id)) + return false; + + bool hovered, held; + bool pressed = ButtonBehavior(bb, id, &hovered, &held, flags); + + return pressed; +} + +bool ImGui::ArrowButtonEx(const char* str_id, ImGuiDir dir, ImVec2 size, ImGuiButtonFlags flags) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + if (window->SkipItems) + return false; + + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + const ImGuiID id = window->GetID(str_id); + const ImRect bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + size); + const float default_size = GetFrameHeight(); + ItemSize(size, (size.y >= default_size) ? g.Style.FramePadding.y : -1.0f); + if (!ItemAdd(bb, id)) + return false; + + if (g.LastItemData.InFlags & ImGuiItemFlags_ButtonRepeat) + flags |= ImGuiButtonFlags_Repeat; + + bool hovered, held; + bool pressed = ButtonBehavior(bb, id, &hovered, &held, flags); + + // Render + const ImU32 bg_col = GetColorU32((held && hovered) ? ImGuiCol_ButtonActive : hovered ? ImGuiCol_ButtonHovered : ImGuiCol_Button); + const ImU32 text_col = GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text); + RenderNavHighlight(bb, id); + RenderFrame(bb.Min, bb.Max, bg_col, true, g.Style.FrameRounding); + RenderArrow(window->DrawList, bb.Min + ImVec2(ImMax(0.0f, (size.x - g.FontSize) * 0.5f), ImMax(0.0f, (size.y - g.FontSize) * 0.5f)), text_col, dir); + + return pressed; +} + +bool ImGui::ArrowButton(const char* str_id, ImGuiDir dir) +{ + float sz = GetFrameHeight(); + return ArrowButtonEx(str_id, dir, ImVec2(sz, sz), ImGuiButtonFlags_None); +} + +// Button to close a window +bool ImGui::CloseButton(ImGuiID id, const ImVec2& pos) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + + // Tweak 1: Shrink hit-testing area if button covers an abnormally large proportion of the visible region. That's in order to facilitate moving the window away. (#3825) + // This may better be applied as a general hit-rect reduction mechanism for all widgets to ensure the area to move window is always accessible? + const ImRect bb(pos, pos + ImVec2(g.FontSize, g.FontSize) + g.Style.FramePadding * 2.0f); + ImRect bb_interact = bb; + const float area_to_visible_ratio = window->OuterRectClipped.GetArea() / bb.GetArea(); + if (area_to_visible_ratio < 1.5f) + bb_interact.Expand(ImFloor(bb_interact.GetSize() * -0.25f)); + + // Tweak 2: We intentionally allow interaction when clipped so that a mechanical Alt,Right,Activate sequence can always close a window. + // (this isn't the regular behavior of buttons, but it doesn't affect the user much because navigation tends to keep items visible). + bool is_clipped = !ItemAdd(bb_interact, id); + + bool hovered, held; + bool pressed = ButtonBehavior(bb_interact, id, &hovered, &held); + if (is_clipped) + return pressed; + + // Render + // FIXME: Clarify this mess + ImU32 col = GetColorU32(held ? ImGuiCol_ButtonActive : ImGuiCol_ButtonHovered); + ImVec2 center = bb.GetCenter(); + if (hovered) + window->DrawList->AddCircleFilled(center, ImMax(2.0f, g.FontSize * 0.5f + 1.0f), col, 12); + + float cross_extent = g.FontSize * 0.5f * 0.7071f - 1.0f; + ImU32 cross_col = GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text); + center -= ImVec2(0.5f, 0.5f); + window->DrawList->AddLine(center + ImVec2(+cross_extent, +cross_extent), center + ImVec2(-cross_extent, -cross_extent), cross_col, 1.0f); + window->DrawList->AddLine(center + ImVec2(+cross_extent, -cross_extent), center + ImVec2(-cross_extent, +cross_extent), cross_col, 1.0f); + + return pressed; +} + +bool ImGui::CollapseButton(ImGuiID id, const ImVec2& pos) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + + ImRect bb(pos, pos + ImVec2(g.FontSize, g.FontSize) + g.Style.FramePadding * 2.0f); + ItemAdd(bb, id); + bool hovered, held; + bool pressed = ButtonBehavior(bb, id, &hovered, &held, ImGuiButtonFlags_None); + + // Render + ImU32 bg_col = GetColorU32((held && hovered) ? ImGuiCol_ButtonActive : hovered ? ImGuiCol_ButtonHovered : ImGuiCol_Button); + ImU32 text_col = GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text); + ImVec2 center = bb.GetCenter(); + if (hovered || held) + window->DrawList->AddCircleFilled(center/*+ ImVec2(0.0f, -0.5f)*/, g.FontSize * 0.5f + 1.0f, bg_col, 12); + RenderArrow(window->DrawList, bb.Min + g.Style.FramePadding, text_col, window->Collapsed ? ImGuiDir_Right : ImGuiDir_Down, 1.0f); + + // Switch to moving the window after mouse is moved beyond the initial drag threshold + if (IsItemActive() && IsMouseDragging(0)) + StartMouseMovingWindow(window); + + return pressed; +} + +ImGuiID ImGui::GetWindowScrollbarID(ImGuiWindow* window, ImGuiAxis axis) +{ + return window->GetIDNoKeepAlive(axis == ImGuiAxis_X ? "#SCROLLX" : "#SCROLLY"); +} + +// Return scrollbar rectangle, must only be called for corresponding axis if window->ScrollbarX/Y is set. +ImRect ImGui::GetWindowScrollbarRect(ImGuiWindow* window, ImGuiAxis axis) +{ + const ImRect outer_rect = window->Rect(); + const ImRect inner_rect = window->InnerRect; + const float border_size = window->WindowBorderSize; + const float scrollbar_size = window->ScrollbarSizes[axis ^ 1]; // (ScrollbarSizes.x = width of Y scrollbar; ScrollbarSizes.y = height of X scrollbar) + IM_ASSERT(scrollbar_size > 0.0f); + if (axis == ImGuiAxis_X) + return ImRect(inner_rect.Min.x, ImMax(outer_rect.Min.y, outer_rect.Max.y - border_size - scrollbar_size), inner_rect.Max.x, outer_rect.Max.y); + else + return ImRect(ImMax(outer_rect.Min.x, outer_rect.Max.x - border_size - scrollbar_size), inner_rect.Min.y, outer_rect.Max.x, inner_rect.Max.y); +} + +void ImGui::Scrollbar(ImGuiAxis axis) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + + const ImGuiID id = GetWindowScrollbarID(window, axis); + KeepAliveID(id); + + // Calculate scrollbar bounding box + ImRect bb = GetWindowScrollbarRect(window, axis); + ImDrawFlags rounding_corners = ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersNone; + if (axis == ImGuiAxis_X) + { + rounding_corners |= ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersBottomLeft; + if (!window->ScrollbarY) + rounding_corners |= ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersBottomRight; + } + else + { + if ((window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar) && !(window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_MenuBar)) + rounding_corners |= ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersTopRight; + if (!window->ScrollbarX) + rounding_corners |= ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersBottomRight; + } + float size_avail = window->InnerRect.Max[axis] - window->InnerRect.Min[axis]; + float size_contents = window->ContentSize[axis] + window->WindowPadding[axis] * 2.0f; + ScrollbarEx(bb, id, axis, &window->Scroll[axis], size_avail, size_contents, rounding_corners); +} + +// Vertical/Horizontal scrollbar +// The entire piece of code below is rather confusing because: +// - We handle absolute seeking (when first clicking outside the grab) and relative manipulation (afterward or when clicking inside the grab) +// - We store values as normalized ratio and in a form that allows the window content to change while we are holding on a scrollbar +// - We handle both horizontal and vertical scrollbars, which makes the terminology not ideal. +// Still, the code should probably be made simpler.. +bool ImGui::ScrollbarEx(const ImRect& bb_frame, ImGuiID id, ImGuiAxis axis, float* p_scroll_v, float size_avail_v, float size_contents_v, ImDrawFlags flags) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + if (window->SkipItems) + return false; + + const float bb_frame_width = bb_frame.GetWidth(); + const float bb_frame_height = bb_frame.GetHeight(); + if (bb_frame_width <= 0.0f || bb_frame_height <= 0.0f) + return false; + + // When we are too small, start hiding and disabling the grab (this reduce visual noise on very small window and facilitate using the window resize grab) + float alpha = 1.0f; + if ((axis == ImGuiAxis_Y) && bb_frame_height < g.FontSize + g.Style.FramePadding.y * 2.0f) + alpha = ImSaturate((bb_frame_height - g.FontSize) / (g.Style.FramePadding.y * 2.0f)); + if (alpha <= 0.0f) + return false; + + const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style; + const bool allow_interaction = (alpha >= 1.0f); + + ImRect bb = bb_frame; + bb.Expand(ImVec2(-ImClamp(IM_FLOOR((bb_frame_width - 2.0f) * 0.5f), 0.0f, 3.0f), -ImClamp(IM_FLOOR((bb_frame_height - 2.0f) * 0.5f), 0.0f, 3.0f))); + + // V denote the main, longer axis of the scrollbar (= height for a vertical scrollbar) + const float scrollbar_size_v = (axis == ImGuiAxis_X) ? bb.GetWidth() : bb.GetHeight(); + + // Calculate the height of our grabbable box. It generally represent the amount visible (vs the total scrollable amount) + // But we maintain a minimum size in pixel to allow for the user to still aim inside. + IM_ASSERT(ImMax(size_contents_v, size_avail_v) > 0.0f); // Adding this assert to check if the ImMax(XXX,1.0f) is still needed. PLEASE CONTACT ME if this triggers. + const float win_size_v = ImMax(ImMax(size_contents_v, size_avail_v), 1.0f); + const float grab_h_pixels = ImClamp(scrollbar_size_v * (size_avail_v / win_size_v), style.GrabMinSize, scrollbar_size_v); + const float grab_h_norm = grab_h_pixels / scrollbar_size_v; + + // Handle input right away. None of the code of Begin() is relying on scrolling position before calling Scrollbar(). + bool held = false; + bool hovered = false; + ButtonBehavior(bb, id, &hovered, &held, ImGuiButtonFlags_NoNavFocus); + + float scroll_max = ImMax(1.0f, size_contents_v - size_avail_v); + float scroll_ratio = ImSaturate(*p_scroll_v / scroll_max); + float grab_v_norm = scroll_ratio * (scrollbar_size_v - grab_h_pixels) / scrollbar_size_v; // Grab position in normalized space + if (held && allow_interaction && grab_h_norm < 1.0f) + { + float scrollbar_pos_v = bb.Min[axis]; + float mouse_pos_v = g.IO.MousePos[axis]; + + // Click position in scrollbar normalized space (0.0f->1.0f) + const float clicked_v_norm = ImSaturate((mouse_pos_v - scrollbar_pos_v) / scrollbar_size_v); + SetHoveredID(id); + + bool seek_absolute = false; + if (g.ActiveIdIsJustActivated) + { + // On initial click calculate the distance between mouse and the center of the grab + seek_absolute = (clicked_v_norm < grab_v_norm || clicked_v_norm > grab_v_norm + grab_h_norm); + if (seek_absolute) + g.ScrollbarClickDeltaToGrabCenter = 0.0f; + else + g.ScrollbarClickDeltaToGrabCenter = clicked_v_norm - grab_v_norm - grab_h_norm * 0.5f; + } + + // Apply scroll (p_scroll_v will generally point on one member of window->Scroll) + // It is ok to modify Scroll here because we are being called in Begin() after the calculation of ContentSize and before setting up our starting position + const float scroll_v_norm = ImSaturate((clicked_v_norm - g.ScrollbarClickDeltaToGrabCenter - grab_h_norm * 0.5f) / (1.0f - grab_h_norm)); + *p_scroll_v = IM_ROUND(scroll_v_norm * scroll_max);//(win_size_contents_v - win_size_v)); + + // Update values for rendering + scroll_ratio = ImSaturate(*p_scroll_v / scroll_max); + grab_v_norm = scroll_ratio * (scrollbar_size_v - grab_h_pixels) / scrollbar_size_v; + + // Update distance to grab now that we have seeked and saturated + if (seek_absolute) + g.ScrollbarClickDeltaToGrabCenter = clicked_v_norm - grab_v_norm - grab_h_norm * 0.5f; + } + + // Render + const ImU32 bg_col = GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_ScrollbarBg); + const ImU32 grab_col = GetColorU32(held ? ImGuiCol_ScrollbarGrabActive : hovered ? ImGuiCol_ScrollbarGrabHovered : ImGuiCol_ScrollbarGrab, alpha); + window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(bb_frame.Min, bb_frame.Max, bg_col, window->WindowRounding, flags); + ImRect grab_rect; + if (axis == ImGuiAxis_X) + grab_rect = ImRect(ImLerp(bb.Min.x, bb.Max.x, grab_v_norm), bb.Min.y, ImLerp(bb.Min.x, bb.Max.x, grab_v_norm) + grab_h_pixels, bb.Max.y); + else + grab_rect = ImRect(bb.Min.x, ImLerp(bb.Min.y, bb.Max.y, grab_v_norm), bb.Max.x, ImLerp(bb.Min.y, bb.Max.y, grab_v_norm) + grab_h_pixels); + window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(grab_rect.Min, grab_rect.Max, grab_col, style.ScrollbarRounding); + + return held; +} + +void ImGui::Image(ImTextureID user_texture_id, const ImVec2& size, const ImVec2& uv0, const ImVec2& uv1, const ImVec4& tint_col, const ImVec4& border_col) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + if (window->SkipItems) + return; + + ImRect bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + size); + if (border_col.w > 0.0f) + bb.Max += ImVec2(2, 2); + ItemSize(bb); + if (!ItemAdd(bb, 0)) + return; + + if (border_col.w > 0.0f) + { + window->DrawList->AddRect(bb.Min, bb.Max, GetColorU32(border_col), 0.0f); + window->DrawList->AddImage(user_texture_id, bb.Min + ImVec2(1, 1), bb.Max - ImVec2(1, 1), uv0, uv1, GetColorU32(tint_col)); + } + else + { + window->DrawList->AddImage(user_texture_id, bb.Min, bb.Max, uv0, uv1, GetColorU32(tint_col)); + } +} + +// ImageButton() is flawed as 'id' is always derived from 'texture_id' (see #2464 #1390) +// We provide this internal helper to write your own variant while we figure out how to redesign the public ImageButton() API. +bool ImGui::ImageButtonEx(ImGuiID id, ImTextureID texture_id, const ImVec2& size, const ImVec2& uv0, const ImVec2& uv1, const ImVec2& padding, const ImVec4& bg_col, const ImVec4& tint_col) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + if (window->SkipItems) + return false; + + const ImRect bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + size + padding * 2); + ItemSize(bb); + if (!ItemAdd(bb, id)) + return false; + + bool hovered, held; + bool pressed = ButtonBehavior(bb, id, &hovered, &held); + + // Render + const ImU32 col = GetColorU32((held && hovered) ? ImGuiCol_ButtonActive : hovered ? ImGuiCol_ButtonHovered : ImGuiCol_Button); + RenderNavHighlight(bb, id); + RenderFrame(bb.Min, bb.Max, col, true, ImClamp((float)ImMin(padding.x, padding.y), 0.0f, g.Style.FrameRounding)); + if (bg_col.w > 0.0f) + window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(bb.Min + padding, bb.Max - padding, GetColorU32(bg_col)); + window->DrawList->AddImage(texture_id, bb.Min + padding, bb.Max - padding, uv0, uv1, GetColorU32(tint_col)); + + return pressed; +} + +// frame_padding < 0: uses FramePadding from style (default) +// frame_padding = 0: no framing +// frame_padding > 0: set framing size +bool ImGui::ImageButton(ImTextureID user_texture_id, const ImVec2& size, const ImVec2& uv0, const ImVec2& uv1, int frame_padding, const ImVec4& bg_col, const ImVec4& tint_col) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + if (window->SkipItems) + return false; + + // Default to using texture ID as ID. User can still push string/integer prefixes. + PushID((void*)(intptr_t)user_texture_id); + const ImGuiID id = window->GetID("#image"); + PopID(); + + const ImVec2 padding = (frame_padding >= 0) ? ImVec2((float)frame_padding, (float)frame_padding) : g.Style.FramePadding; + return ImageButtonEx(id, user_texture_id, size, uv0, uv1, padding, bg_col, tint_col); +} + +bool ImGui::Checkbox(const char* label, bool* v) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + if (window->SkipItems) + return false; + + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style; + const ImGuiID id = window->GetID(label); + const ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true); + + const float square_sz = GetFrameHeight(); + const ImVec2 pos = window->DC.CursorPos; + const ImRect total_bb(pos, pos + ImVec2(square_sz + (label_size.x > 0.0f ? style.ItemInnerSpacing.x + label_size.x : 0.0f), label_size.y + style.FramePadding.y * 2.0f)); + ItemSize(total_bb, style.FramePadding.y); + if (!ItemAdd(total_bb, id)) + { + IMGUI_TEST_ENGINE_ITEM_INFO(id, label, g.LastItemData.StatusFlags | ImGuiItemStatusFlags_Checkable | (*v ? ImGuiItemStatusFlags_Checked : 0)); + return false; + } + + bool hovered, held; + bool pressed = ButtonBehavior(total_bb, id, &hovered, &held); + if (pressed) + { + *v = !(*v); + MarkItemEdited(id); + } + + const ImRect check_bb(pos, pos + ImVec2(square_sz, square_sz)); + RenderNavHighlight(total_bb, id); + RenderFrame(check_bb.Min, check_bb.Max, GetColorU32((held && hovered) ? ImGuiCol_FrameBgActive : hovered ? ImGuiCol_FrameBgHovered : ImGuiCol_FrameBg), true, style.FrameRounding); + ImU32 check_col = GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_CheckMark); + bool mixed_value = (g.LastItemData.InFlags & ImGuiItemFlags_MixedValue) != 0; + if (mixed_value) + { + // Undocumented tristate/mixed/indeterminate checkbox (#2644) + // This may seem awkwardly designed because the aim is to make ImGuiItemFlags_MixedValue supported by all widgets (not just checkbox) + ImVec2 pad(ImMax(1.0f, IM_FLOOR(square_sz / 3.6f)), ImMax(1.0f, IM_FLOOR(square_sz / 3.6f))); + window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(check_bb.Min + pad, check_bb.Max - pad, check_col, style.FrameRounding); + } + else if (*v) + { + const float pad = ImMax(1.0f, IM_FLOOR(square_sz / 6.0f)); + RenderCheckMark(window->DrawList, check_bb.Min + ImVec2(pad, pad), check_col, square_sz - pad * 2.0f); + } + + ImVec2 label_pos = ImVec2(check_bb.Max.x + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x, check_bb.Min.y + style.FramePadding.y); + if (g.LogEnabled) + LogRenderedText(&label_pos, mixed_value ? "[~]" : *v ? "[x]" : "[ ]"); + if (label_size.x > 0.0f) + RenderText(label_pos, label); + + IMGUI_TEST_ENGINE_ITEM_INFO(id, label, g.LastItemData.StatusFlags | ImGuiItemStatusFlags_Checkable | (*v ? ImGuiItemStatusFlags_Checked : 0)); + return pressed; +} + +template +bool ImGui::CheckboxFlagsT(const char* label, T* flags, T flags_value) +{ + bool all_on = (*flags & flags_value) == flags_value; + bool any_on = (*flags & flags_value) != 0; + bool pressed; + if (!all_on && any_on) + { + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiItemFlags backup_item_flags = g.CurrentItemFlags; + g.CurrentItemFlags |= ImGuiItemFlags_MixedValue; + pressed = Checkbox(label, &all_on); + g.CurrentItemFlags = backup_item_flags; + } + else + { + pressed = Checkbox(label, &all_on); + + } + if (pressed) + { + if (all_on) + *flags |= flags_value; + else + *flags &= ~flags_value; + } + return pressed; +} + +bool ImGui::CheckboxFlags(const char* label, int* flags, int flags_value) +{ + return CheckboxFlagsT(label, flags, flags_value); +} + +bool ImGui::CheckboxFlags(const char* label, unsigned int* flags, unsigned int flags_value) +{ + return CheckboxFlagsT(label, flags, flags_value); +} + +bool ImGui::CheckboxFlags(const char* label, ImS64* flags, ImS64 flags_value) +{ + return CheckboxFlagsT(label, flags, flags_value); +} + +bool ImGui::CheckboxFlags(const char* label, ImU64* flags, ImU64 flags_value) +{ + return CheckboxFlagsT(label, flags, flags_value); +} + +bool ImGui::RadioButton(const char* label, bool active) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + if (window->SkipItems) + return false; + + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style; + const ImGuiID id = window->GetID(label); + const ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true); + + const float square_sz = GetFrameHeight(); + const ImVec2 pos = window->DC.CursorPos; + const ImRect check_bb(pos, pos + ImVec2(square_sz, square_sz)); + const ImRect total_bb(pos, pos + ImVec2(square_sz + (label_size.x > 0.0f ? style.ItemInnerSpacing.x + label_size.x : 0.0f), label_size.y + style.FramePadding.y * 2.0f)); + ItemSize(total_bb, style.FramePadding.y); + if (!ItemAdd(total_bb, id)) + return false; + + ImVec2 center = check_bb.GetCenter(); + center.x = IM_ROUND(center.x); + center.y = IM_ROUND(center.y); + const float radius = (square_sz - 1.0f) * 0.5f; + + bool hovered, held; + bool pressed = ButtonBehavior(total_bb, id, &hovered, &held); + if (pressed) + MarkItemEdited(id); + + RenderNavHighlight(total_bb, id); + window->DrawList->AddCircleFilled(center, radius, GetColorU32((held && hovered) ? ImGuiCol_FrameBgActive : hovered ? ImGuiCol_FrameBgHovered : ImGuiCol_FrameBg), 16); + if (active) + { + const float pad = ImMax(1.0f, IM_FLOOR(square_sz / 6.0f)); + window->DrawList->AddCircleFilled(center, radius - pad, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_CheckMark), 16); + } + + if (style.FrameBorderSize > 0.0f) + { + window->DrawList->AddCircle(center + ImVec2(1, 1), radius, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_BorderShadow), 16, style.FrameBorderSize); + window->DrawList->AddCircle(center, radius, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Border), 16, style.FrameBorderSize); + } + + ImVec2 label_pos = ImVec2(check_bb.Max.x + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x, check_bb.Min.y + style.FramePadding.y); + if (g.LogEnabled) + LogRenderedText(&label_pos, active ? "(x)" : "( )"); + if (label_size.x > 0.0f) + RenderText(label_pos, label); + + IMGUI_TEST_ENGINE_ITEM_INFO(id, label, g.LastItemData.StatusFlags); + return pressed; +} + +// FIXME: This would work nicely if it was a public template, e.g. 'template RadioButton(const char* label, T* v, T v_button)', but I'm not sure how we would expose it.. +bool ImGui::RadioButton(const char* label, int* v, int v_button) +{ + const bool pressed = RadioButton(label, *v == v_button); + if (pressed) + *v = v_button; + return pressed; +} + +// size_arg (for each axis) < 0.0f: align to end, 0.0f: auto, > 0.0f: specified size +void ImGui::ProgressBar(float fraction, const ImVec2& size_arg, const char* overlay) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + if (window->SkipItems) + return; + + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style; + + ImVec2 pos = window->DC.CursorPos; + ImVec2 size = CalcItemSize(size_arg, CalcItemWidth(), g.FontSize + style.FramePadding.y * 2.0f); + ImRect bb(pos, pos + size); + ItemSize(size, style.FramePadding.y); + if (!ItemAdd(bb, 0)) + return; + + // Render + fraction = ImSaturate(fraction); + RenderFrame(bb.Min, bb.Max, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_FrameBg), true, style.FrameRounding); + bb.Expand(ImVec2(-style.FrameBorderSize, -style.FrameBorderSize)); + const ImVec2 fill_br = ImVec2(ImLerp(bb.Min.x, bb.Max.x, fraction), bb.Max.y); + RenderRectFilledRangeH(window->DrawList, bb, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_PlotHistogram), 0.0f, fraction, style.FrameRounding); + + // Default displaying the fraction as percentage string, but user can override it + char overlay_buf[32]; + if (!overlay) + { + ImFormatString(overlay_buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(overlay_buf), "%.0f%%", fraction * 100 + 0.01f); + overlay = overlay_buf; + } + + ImVec2 overlay_size = CalcTextSize(overlay, NULL); + if (overlay_size.x > 0.0f) + RenderTextClipped(ImVec2(ImClamp(fill_br.x + style.ItemSpacing.x, bb.Min.x, bb.Max.x - overlay_size.x - style.ItemInnerSpacing.x), bb.Min.y), bb.Max, overlay, NULL, &overlay_size, ImVec2(0.0f, 0.5f), &bb); +} + +void ImGui::Bullet() +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + if (window->SkipItems) + return; + + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style; + const float line_height = ImMax(ImMin(window->DC.CurrLineSize.y, g.FontSize + g.Style.FramePadding.y * 2), g.FontSize); + const ImRect bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + ImVec2(g.FontSize, line_height)); + ItemSize(bb); + if (!ItemAdd(bb, 0)) + { + SameLine(0, style.FramePadding.x * 2); + return; + } + + // Render and stay on same line + ImU32 text_col = GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text); + RenderBullet(window->DrawList, bb.Min + ImVec2(style.FramePadding.x + g.FontSize * 0.5f, line_height * 0.5f), text_col); + SameLine(0, style.FramePadding.x * 2.0f); +} + +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Widgets: Low-level Layout helpers +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// - Spacing() +// - Dummy() +// - NewLine() +// - AlignTextToFramePadding() +// - SeparatorEx() [Internal] +// - Separator() +// - SplitterBehavior() [Internal] +// - ShrinkWidths() [Internal] +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +void ImGui::Spacing() +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + if (window->SkipItems) + return; + ItemSize(ImVec2(0, 0)); +} + +void ImGui::Dummy(const ImVec2& size) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + if (window->SkipItems) + return; + + const ImRect bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + size); + ItemSize(size); + ItemAdd(bb, 0); +} + +void ImGui::NewLine() +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + if (window->SkipItems) + return; + + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + const ImGuiLayoutType backup_layout_type = window->DC.LayoutType; + window->DC.LayoutType = ImGuiLayoutType_Vertical; + if (window->DC.CurrLineSize.y > 0.0f) // In the event that we are on a line with items that is smaller that FontSize high, we will preserve its height. + ItemSize(ImVec2(0, 0)); + else + ItemSize(ImVec2(0.0f, g.FontSize)); + window->DC.LayoutType = backup_layout_type; +} + +void ImGui::AlignTextToFramePadding() +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + if (window->SkipItems) + return; + + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + window->DC.CurrLineSize.y = ImMax(window->DC.CurrLineSize.y, g.FontSize + g.Style.FramePadding.y * 2); + window->DC.CurrLineTextBaseOffset = ImMax(window->DC.CurrLineTextBaseOffset, g.Style.FramePadding.y); +} + +// Horizontal/vertical separating line +void ImGui::SeparatorEx(ImGuiSeparatorFlags flags) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + if (window->SkipItems) + return; + + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + IM_ASSERT(ImIsPowerOfTwo(flags & (ImGuiSeparatorFlags_Horizontal | ImGuiSeparatorFlags_Vertical))); // Check that only 1 option is selected + + float thickness_draw = 1.0f; + float thickness_layout = 0.0f; + if (flags & ImGuiSeparatorFlags_Vertical) + { + // Vertical separator, for menu bars (use current line height). Not exposed because it is misleading and it doesn't have an effect on regular layout. + float y1 = window->DC.CursorPos.y; + float y2 = window->DC.CursorPos.y + window->DC.CurrLineSize.y; + const ImRect bb(ImVec2(window->DC.CursorPos.x, y1), ImVec2(window->DC.CursorPos.x + thickness_draw, y2)); + ItemSize(ImVec2(thickness_layout, 0.0f)); + if (!ItemAdd(bb, 0)) + return; + + // Draw + window->DrawList->AddLine(ImVec2(bb.Min.x, bb.Min.y), ImVec2(bb.Min.x, bb.Max.y), GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Separator)); + if (g.LogEnabled) + LogText(" |"); + } + else if (flags & ImGuiSeparatorFlags_Horizontal) + { + // Horizontal Separator + float x1 = window->Pos.x; + float x2 = window->Pos.x + window->Size.x; + + // FIXME-WORKRECT: old hack (#205) until we decide of consistent behavior with WorkRect/Indent and Separator + if (g.GroupStack.Size > 0 && g.GroupStack.back().WindowID == window->ID) + x1 += window->DC.Indent.x; + + ImGuiOldColumns* columns = (flags & ImGuiSeparatorFlags_SpanAllColumns) ? window->DC.CurrentColumns : NULL; + if (columns) + PushColumnsBackground(); + + // We don't provide our width to the layout so that it doesn't get feed back into AutoFit + const ImRect bb(ImVec2(x1, window->DC.CursorPos.y), ImVec2(x2, window->DC.CursorPos.y + thickness_draw)); + ItemSize(ImVec2(0.0f, thickness_layout)); + const bool item_visible = ItemAdd(bb, 0); + if (item_visible) + { + // Draw + window->DrawList->AddLine(bb.Min, ImVec2(bb.Max.x, bb.Min.y), GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Separator)); + if (g.LogEnabled) + LogRenderedText(&bb.Min, "--------------------------------\n"); + + } + if (columns) + { + PopColumnsBackground(); + columns->LineMinY = window->DC.CursorPos.y; + } + } +} + +void ImGui::Separator() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + if (window->SkipItems) + return; + + // Those flags should eventually be overridable by the user + ImGuiSeparatorFlags flags = (window->DC.LayoutType == ImGuiLayoutType_Horizontal) ? ImGuiSeparatorFlags_Vertical : ImGuiSeparatorFlags_Horizontal; + flags |= ImGuiSeparatorFlags_SpanAllColumns; + SeparatorEx(flags); +} + +// Using 'hover_visibility_delay' allows us to hide the highlight and mouse cursor for a short time, which can be convenient to reduce visual noise. +bool ImGui::SplitterBehavior(const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id, ImGuiAxis axis, float* size1, float* size2, float min_size1, float min_size2, float hover_extend, float hover_visibility_delay) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + + const ImGuiItemFlags item_flags_backup = g.CurrentItemFlags; + g.CurrentItemFlags |= ImGuiItemFlags_NoNav | ImGuiItemFlags_NoNavDefaultFocus; + bool item_add = ItemAdd(bb, id); + g.CurrentItemFlags = item_flags_backup; + if (!item_add) + return false; + + bool hovered, held; + ImRect bb_interact = bb; + bb_interact.Expand(axis == ImGuiAxis_Y ? ImVec2(0.0f, hover_extend) : ImVec2(hover_extend, 0.0f)); + ButtonBehavior(bb_interact, id, &hovered, &held, ImGuiButtonFlags_FlattenChildren | ImGuiButtonFlags_AllowItemOverlap); + if (hovered) + g.LastItemData.StatusFlags |= ImGuiItemStatusFlags_HoveredRect; // for IsItemHovered(), because bb_interact is larger than bb + if (g.ActiveId != id) + SetItemAllowOverlap(); + + if (held || (hovered && g.HoveredIdPreviousFrame == id && g.HoveredIdTimer >= hover_visibility_delay)) + SetMouseCursor(axis == ImGuiAxis_Y ? ImGuiMouseCursor_ResizeNS : ImGuiMouseCursor_ResizeEW); + + ImRect bb_render = bb; + if (held) + { + ImVec2 mouse_delta_2d = g.IO.MousePos - g.ActiveIdClickOffset - bb_interact.Min; + float mouse_delta = (axis == ImGuiAxis_Y) ? mouse_delta_2d.y : mouse_delta_2d.x; + + // Minimum pane size + float size_1_maximum_delta = ImMax(0.0f, *size1 - min_size1); + float size_2_maximum_delta = ImMax(0.0f, *size2 - min_size2); + if (mouse_delta < -size_1_maximum_delta) + mouse_delta = -size_1_maximum_delta; + if (mouse_delta > size_2_maximum_delta) + mouse_delta = size_2_maximum_delta; + + // Apply resize + if (mouse_delta != 0.0f) + { + if (mouse_delta < 0.0f) + IM_ASSERT(*size1 + mouse_delta >= min_size1); + if (mouse_delta > 0.0f) + IM_ASSERT(*size2 - mouse_delta >= min_size2); + *size1 += mouse_delta; + *size2 -= mouse_delta; + bb_render.Translate((axis == ImGuiAxis_X) ? ImVec2(mouse_delta, 0.0f) : ImVec2(0.0f, mouse_delta)); + MarkItemEdited(id); + } + } + + // Render + const ImU32 col = GetColorU32(held ? ImGuiCol_SeparatorActive : (hovered && g.HoveredIdTimer >= hover_visibility_delay) ? ImGuiCol_SeparatorHovered : ImGuiCol_Separator); + window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(bb_render.Min, bb_render.Max, col, 0.0f); + + return held; +} + +static int IMGUI_CDECL ShrinkWidthItemComparer(const void* lhs, const void* rhs) +{ + const ImGuiShrinkWidthItem* a = (const ImGuiShrinkWidthItem*)lhs; + const ImGuiShrinkWidthItem* b = (const ImGuiShrinkWidthItem*)rhs; + if (int d = (int)(b->Width - a->Width)) + return d; + return (b->Index - a->Index); +} + +// Shrink excess width from a set of item, by removing width from the larger items first. +// Set items Width to -1.0f to disable shrinking this item. +void ImGui::ShrinkWidths(ImGuiShrinkWidthItem* items, int count, float width_excess) +{ + if (count == 1) + { + if (items[0].Width >= 0.0f) + items[0].Width = ImMax(items[0].Width - width_excess, 1.0f); + return; + } + ImQsort(items, (size_t)count, sizeof(ImGuiShrinkWidthItem), ShrinkWidthItemComparer); + int count_same_width = 1; + while (width_excess > 0.0f && count_same_width < count) + { + while (count_same_width < count && items[0].Width <= items[count_same_width].Width) + count_same_width++; + float max_width_to_remove_per_item = (count_same_width < count && items[count_same_width].Width >= 0.0f) ? (items[0].Width - items[count_same_width].Width) : (items[0].Width - 1.0f); + if (max_width_to_remove_per_item <= 0.0f) + break; + float width_to_remove_per_item = ImMin(width_excess / count_same_width, max_width_to_remove_per_item); + for (int item_n = 0; item_n < count_same_width; item_n++) + items[item_n].Width -= width_to_remove_per_item; + width_excess -= width_to_remove_per_item * count_same_width; + } + + // Round width and redistribute remainder left-to-right (could make it an option of the function?) + // Ensure that e.g. the right-most tab of a shrunk tab-bar always reaches exactly at the same distance from the right-most edge of the tab bar separator. + width_excess = 0.0f; + for (int n = 0; n < count; n++) + { + float width_rounded = ImFloor(items[n].Width); + width_excess += items[n].Width - width_rounded; + items[n].Width = width_rounded; + } + if (width_excess > 0.0f) + for (int n = 0; n < count; n++) + if (items[n].Index < (int)(width_excess + 0.01f)) + items[n].Width += 1.0f; +} + +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Widgets: ComboBox +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// - CalcMaxPopupHeightFromItemCount() [Internal] +// - BeginCombo() +// - BeginComboPopup() [Internal] +// - EndCombo() +// - BeginComboPreview() [Internal] +// - EndComboPreview() [Internal] +// - Combo() +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +static float CalcMaxPopupHeightFromItemCount(int items_count) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + if (items_count <= 0) + return FLT_MAX; + return (g.FontSize + g.Style.ItemSpacing.y) * items_count - g.Style.ItemSpacing.y + (g.Style.WindowPadding.y * 2); +} + +bool ImGui::BeginCombo(const char* label, const char* preview_value, ImGuiComboFlags flags) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + + ImGuiNextWindowDataFlags backup_next_window_data_flags = g.NextWindowData.Flags; + g.NextWindowData.ClearFlags(); // We behave like Begin() and need to consume those values + if (window->SkipItems) + return false; + + const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style; + const ImGuiID id = window->GetID(label); + IM_ASSERT((flags & (ImGuiComboFlags_NoArrowButton | ImGuiComboFlags_NoPreview)) != (ImGuiComboFlags_NoArrowButton | ImGuiComboFlags_NoPreview)); // Can't use both flags together + + const float arrow_size = (flags & ImGuiComboFlags_NoArrowButton) ? 0.0f : GetFrameHeight(); + const ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true); + const float w = (flags & ImGuiComboFlags_NoPreview) ? arrow_size : CalcItemWidth(); + const ImRect bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + ImVec2(w, label_size.y + style.FramePadding.y * 2.0f)); + const ImRect total_bb(bb.Min, bb.Max + ImVec2(label_size.x > 0.0f ? style.ItemInnerSpacing.x + label_size.x : 0.0f, 0.0f)); + ItemSize(total_bb, style.FramePadding.y); + if (!ItemAdd(total_bb, id, &bb)) + return false; + + // Open on click + bool hovered, held; + bool pressed = ButtonBehavior(bb, id, &hovered, &held); + const ImGuiID popup_id = ImHashStr("##ComboPopup", 0, id); + bool popup_open = IsPopupOpen(popup_id, ImGuiPopupFlags_None); + if ((pressed || g.NavActivateId == id) && !popup_open) + { + OpenPopupEx(popup_id, ImGuiPopupFlags_None); + popup_open = true; + } + + // Render shape + const ImU32 frame_col = GetColorU32(hovered ? ImGuiCol_FrameBgHovered : ImGuiCol_FrameBg); + const float value_x2 = ImMax(bb.Min.x, bb.Max.x - arrow_size); + RenderNavHighlight(bb, id); + if (!(flags & ImGuiComboFlags_NoPreview)) + window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(bb.Min, ImVec2(value_x2, bb.Max.y), frame_col, style.FrameRounding, (flags & ImGuiComboFlags_NoArrowButton) ? ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersAll : ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersLeft); + if (!(flags & ImGuiComboFlags_NoArrowButton)) + { + ImU32 bg_col = GetColorU32((popup_open || hovered) ? ImGuiCol_ButtonHovered : ImGuiCol_Button); + ImU32 text_col = GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text); + window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(ImVec2(value_x2, bb.Min.y), bb.Max, bg_col, style.FrameRounding, (w <= arrow_size) ? ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersAll : ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersRight); + if (value_x2 + arrow_size - style.FramePadding.x <= bb.Max.x) + RenderArrow(window->DrawList, ImVec2(value_x2 + style.FramePadding.y, bb.Min.y + style.FramePadding.y), text_col, ImGuiDir_Down, 1.0f); + } + RenderFrameBorder(bb.Min, bb.Max, style.FrameRounding); + + // Custom preview + if (flags & ImGuiComboFlags_CustomPreview) + { + g.ComboPreviewData.PreviewRect = ImRect(bb.Min.x, bb.Min.y, value_x2, bb.Max.y); + IM_ASSERT(preview_value == NULL || preview_value[0] == 0); + preview_value = NULL; + } + + // Render preview and label + if (preview_value != NULL && !(flags & ImGuiComboFlags_NoPreview)) + { + if (g.LogEnabled) + LogSetNextTextDecoration("{", "}"); + RenderTextClipped(bb.Min + style.FramePadding, ImVec2(value_x2, bb.Max.y), preview_value, NULL, NULL); + } + if (label_size.x > 0) + RenderText(ImVec2(bb.Max.x + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x, bb.Min.y + style.FramePadding.y), label); + + if (!popup_open) + return false; + + g.NextWindowData.Flags = backup_next_window_data_flags; + return BeginComboPopup(popup_id, bb, flags); +} + +bool ImGui::BeginComboPopup(ImGuiID popup_id, const ImRect& bb, ImGuiComboFlags flags) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + if (!IsPopupOpen(popup_id, ImGuiPopupFlags_None)) + { + g.NextWindowData.ClearFlags(); + return false; + } + + // Set popup size + float w = bb.GetWidth(); + if (g.NextWindowData.Flags & ImGuiNextWindowDataFlags_HasSizeConstraint) + { + g.NextWindowData.SizeConstraintRect.Min.x = ImMax(g.NextWindowData.SizeConstraintRect.Min.x, w); + } + else + { + if ((flags & ImGuiComboFlags_HeightMask_) == 0) + flags |= ImGuiComboFlags_HeightRegular; + IM_ASSERT(ImIsPowerOfTwo(flags & ImGuiComboFlags_HeightMask_)); // Only one + int popup_max_height_in_items = -1; + if (flags & ImGuiComboFlags_HeightRegular) popup_max_height_in_items = 8; + else if (flags & ImGuiComboFlags_HeightSmall) popup_max_height_in_items = 4; + else if (flags & ImGuiComboFlags_HeightLarge) popup_max_height_in_items = 20; + SetNextWindowSizeConstraints(ImVec2(w, 0.0f), ImVec2(FLT_MAX, CalcMaxPopupHeightFromItemCount(popup_max_height_in_items))); + } + + // This is essentially a specialized version of BeginPopupEx() + char name[16]; + ImFormatString(name, IM_ARRAYSIZE(name), "##Combo_%02d", g.BeginPopupStack.Size); // Recycle windows based on depth + + // Set position given a custom constraint (peak into expected window size so we can position it) + // FIXME: This might be easier to express with an hypothetical SetNextWindowPosConstraints() function? + // FIXME: This might be moved to Begin() or at least around the same spot where Tooltips and other Popups are calling FindBestWindowPosForPopupEx()? + if (ImGuiWindow* popup_window = FindWindowByName(name)) + if (popup_window->WasActive) + { + // Always override 'AutoPosLastDirection' to not leave a chance for a past value to affect us. + ImVec2 size_expected = CalcWindowNextAutoFitSize(popup_window); + popup_window->AutoPosLastDirection = (flags & ImGuiComboFlags_PopupAlignLeft) ? ImGuiDir_Left : ImGuiDir_Down; // Left = "Below, Toward Left", Down = "Below, Toward Right (default)" + ImRect r_outer = GetPopupAllowedExtentRect(popup_window); + ImVec2 pos = FindBestWindowPosForPopupEx(bb.GetBL(), size_expected, &popup_window->AutoPosLastDirection, r_outer, bb, ImGuiPopupPositionPolicy_ComboBox); + SetNextWindowPos(pos); + } + + // We don't use BeginPopupEx() solely because we have a custom name string, which we could make an argument to BeginPopupEx() + ImGuiWindowFlags window_flags = ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize | ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoResize | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoSavedSettings | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoMove; + PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_WindowPadding, ImVec2(g.Style.FramePadding.x, g.Style.WindowPadding.y)); // Horizontally align ourselves with the framed text + bool ret = Begin(name, NULL, window_flags); + PopStyleVar(); + if (!ret) + { + EndPopup(); + IM_ASSERT(0); // This should never happen as we tested for IsPopupOpen() above + return false; + } + return true; +} + +void ImGui::EndCombo() +{ + EndPopup(); +} + +// Call directly after the BeginCombo/EndCombo block. The preview is designed to only host non-interactive elements +// (Experimental, see GitHub issues: #1658, #4168) +bool ImGui::BeginComboPreview() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + ImGuiComboPreviewData* preview_data = &g.ComboPreviewData; + + if (window->SkipItems || !window->ClipRect.Overlaps(g.LastItemData.Rect)) // FIXME: Because we don't have a ImGuiItemStatusFlags_Visible flag to test last ItemAdd() result + return false; + IM_ASSERT(g.LastItemData.Rect.Min.x == preview_data->PreviewRect.Min.x && g.LastItemData.Rect.Min.y == preview_data->PreviewRect.Min.y); // Didn't call after BeginCombo/EndCombo block or forgot to pass ImGuiComboFlags_CustomPreview flag? + if (!window->ClipRect.Contains(preview_data->PreviewRect)) // Narrower test (optional) + return false; + + // FIXME: This could be contained in a PushWorkRect() api + preview_data->BackupCursorPos = window->DC.CursorPos; + preview_data->BackupCursorMaxPos = window->DC.CursorMaxPos; + preview_data->BackupCursorPosPrevLine = window->DC.CursorPosPrevLine; + preview_data->BackupPrevLineTextBaseOffset = window->DC.PrevLineTextBaseOffset; + preview_data->BackupLayout = window->DC.LayoutType; + window->DC.CursorPos = preview_data->PreviewRect.Min + g.Style.FramePadding; + window->DC.CursorMaxPos = window->DC.CursorPos; + window->DC.LayoutType = ImGuiLayoutType_Horizontal; + PushClipRect(preview_data->PreviewRect.Min, preview_data->PreviewRect.Max, true); + + return true; +} + +void ImGui::EndComboPreview() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + ImGuiComboPreviewData* preview_data = &g.ComboPreviewData; + + // FIXME: Using CursorMaxPos approximation instead of correct AABB which we will store in ImDrawCmd in the future + ImDrawList* draw_list = window->DrawList; + if (window->DC.CursorMaxPos.x < preview_data->PreviewRect.Max.x && window->DC.CursorMaxPos.y < preview_data->PreviewRect.Max.y) + if (draw_list->CmdBuffer.Size > 1) // Unlikely case that the PushClipRect() didn't create a command + { + draw_list->_CmdHeader.ClipRect = draw_list->CmdBuffer[draw_list->CmdBuffer.Size - 1].ClipRect = draw_list->CmdBuffer[draw_list->CmdBuffer.Size - 2].ClipRect; + draw_list->_TryMergeDrawCmds(); + } + PopClipRect(); + window->DC.CursorPos = preview_data->BackupCursorPos; + window->DC.CursorMaxPos = ImMax(window->DC.CursorMaxPos, preview_data->BackupCursorMaxPos); + window->DC.CursorPosPrevLine = preview_data->BackupCursorPosPrevLine; + window->DC.PrevLineTextBaseOffset = preview_data->BackupPrevLineTextBaseOffset; + window->DC.LayoutType = preview_data->BackupLayout; + preview_data->PreviewRect = ImRect(); +} + +// Getter for the old Combo() API: const char*[] +static bool Items_ArrayGetter(void* data, int idx, const char** out_text) +{ + const char* const* items = (const char* const*)data; + if (out_text) + *out_text = items[idx]; + return true; +} + +// Getter for the old Combo() API: "item1\0item2\0item3\0" +static bool Items_SingleStringGetter(void* data, int idx, const char** out_text) +{ + // FIXME-OPT: we could pre-compute the indices to fasten this. But only 1 active combo means the waste is limited. + const char* items_separated_by_zeros = (const char*)data; + int items_count = 0; + const char* p = items_separated_by_zeros; + while (*p) + { + if (idx == items_count) + break; + p += strlen(p) + 1; + items_count++; + } + if (!*p) + return false; + if (out_text) + *out_text = p; + return true; +} + +// Old API, prefer using BeginCombo() nowadays if you can. +bool ImGui::Combo(const char* label, int* current_item, bool (*items_getter)(void*, int, const char**), void* data, int items_count, int popup_max_height_in_items) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + + // Call the getter to obtain the preview string which is a parameter to BeginCombo() + const char* preview_value = NULL; + if (*current_item >= 0 && *current_item < items_count) + items_getter(data, *current_item, &preview_value); + + // The old Combo() API exposed "popup_max_height_in_items". The new more general BeginCombo() API doesn't have/need it, but we emulate it here. + if (popup_max_height_in_items != -1 && !(g.NextWindowData.Flags & ImGuiNextWindowDataFlags_HasSizeConstraint)) + SetNextWindowSizeConstraints(ImVec2(0, 0), ImVec2(FLT_MAX, CalcMaxPopupHeightFromItemCount(popup_max_height_in_items))); + + if (!BeginCombo(label, preview_value, ImGuiComboFlags_None)) + return false; + + // Display items + // FIXME-OPT: Use clipper (but we need to disable it on the appearing frame to make sure our call to SetItemDefaultFocus() is processed) + bool value_changed = false; + for (int i = 0; i < items_count; i++) + { + PushID((void*)(intptr_t)i); + const bool item_selected = (i == *current_item); + const char* item_text; + if (!items_getter(data, i, &item_text)) + item_text = "*Unknown item*"; + if (Selectable(item_text, item_selected)) + { + value_changed = true; + *current_item = i; + } + if (item_selected) + SetItemDefaultFocus(); + PopID(); + } + + EndCombo(); + + if (value_changed) + MarkItemEdited(g.LastItemData.ID); + + return value_changed; +} + +// Combo box helper allowing to pass an array of strings. +bool ImGui::Combo(const char* label, int* current_item, const char* const items[], int items_count, int height_in_items) +{ + const bool value_changed = Combo(label, current_item, Items_ArrayGetter, (void*)items, items_count, height_in_items); + return value_changed; +} + +// Combo box helper allowing to pass all items in a single string literal holding multiple zero-terminated items "item1\0item2\0" +bool ImGui::Combo(const char* label, int* current_item, const char* items_separated_by_zeros, int height_in_items) +{ + int items_count = 0; + const char* p = items_separated_by_zeros; // FIXME-OPT: Avoid computing this, or at least only when combo is open + while (*p) + { + p += strlen(p) + 1; + items_count++; + } + bool value_changed = Combo(label, current_item, Items_SingleStringGetter, (void*)items_separated_by_zeros, items_count, height_in_items); + return value_changed; +} + +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Data Type and Data Formatting Helpers [Internal] +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// - PatchFormatStringFloatToInt() +// - DataTypeGetInfo() +// - DataTypeFormatString() +// - DataTypeApplyOp() +// - DataTypeApplyOpFromText() +// - DataTypeClamp() +// - GetMinimumStepAtDecimalPrecision +// - RoundScalarWithFormat<>() +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +static const ImGuiDataTypeInfo GDataTypeInfo[] = +{ + { sizeof(char), "S8", "%d", "%d" }, // ImGuiDataType_S8 + { sizeof(unsigned char), "U8", "%u", "%u" }, + { sizeof(short), "S16", "%d", "%d" }, // ImGuiDataType_S16 + { sizeof(unsigned short), "U16", "%u", "%u" }, + { sizeof(int), "S32", "%d", "%d" }, // ImGuiDataType_S32 + { sizeof(unsigned int), "U32", "%u", "%u" }, +#ifdef _MSC_VER + { sizeof(ImS64), "S64", "%I64d","%I64d" }, // ImGuiDataType_S64 + { sizeof(ImU64), "U64", "%I64u","%I64u" }, +#else + { sizeof(ImS64), "S64", "%lld", "%lld" }, // ImGuiDataType_S64 + { sizeof(ImU64), "U64", "%llu", "%llu" }, +#endif + { sizeof(float), "float", "%.3f","%f" }, // ImGuiDataType_Float (float are promoted to double in va_arg) + { sizeof(double), "double","%f", "%lf" }, // ImGuiDataType_Double +}; +IM_STATIC_ASSERT(IM_ARRAYSIZE(GDataTypeInfo) == ImGuiDataType_COUNT); + +// FIXME-LEGACY: Prior to 1.61 our DragInt() function internally used floats and because of this the compile-time default value for format was "%.0f". +// Even though we changed the compile-time default, we expect users to have carried %f around, which would break the display of DragInt() calls. +// To honor backward compatibility we are rewriting the format string, unless IMGUI_DISABLE_OBSOLETE_FUNCTIONS is enabled. What could possibly go wrong?! +static const char* PatchFormatStringFloatToInt(const char* fmt) +{ + if (fmt[0] == '%' && fmt[1] == '.' && fmt[2] == '0' && fmt[3] == 'f' && fmt[4] == 0) // Fast legacy path for "%.0f" which is expected to be the most common case. + return "%d"; + const char* fmt_start = ImParseFormatFindStart(fmt); // Find % (if any, and ignore %%) + const char* fmt_end = ImParseFormatFindEnd(fmt_start); // Find end of format specifier, which itself is an exercise of confidence/recklessness (because snprintf is dependent on libc or user). + if (fmt_end > fmt_start && fmt_end[-1] == 'f') + { +#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_OBSOLETE_FUNCTIONS + if (fmt_start == fmt && fmt_end[0] == 0) + return "%d"; + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImFormatString(g.TempBuffer, IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.TempBuffer), "%.*s%%d%s", (int)(fmt_start - fmt), fmt, fmt_end); // Honor leading and trailing decorations, but lose alignment/precision. + return g.TempBuffer; +#else + IM_ASSERT(0 && "DragInt(): Invalid format string!"); // Old versions used a default parameter of "%.0f", please replace with e.g. "%d" +#endif + } + return fmt; +} + +const ImGuiDataTypeInfo* ImGui::DataTypeGetInfo(ImGuiDataType data_type) +{ + IM_ASSERT(data_type >= 0 && data_type < ImGuiDataType_COUNT); + return &GDataTypeInfo[data_type]; +} + +int ImGui::DataTypeFormatString(char* buf, int buf_size, ImGuiDataType data_type, const void* p_data, const char* format) +{ + // Signedness doesn't matter when pushing integer arguments + if (data_type == ImGuiDataType_S32 || data_type == ImGuiDataType_U32) + return ImFormatString(buf, buf_size, format, *(const ImU32*)p_data); + if (data_type == ImGuiDataType_S64 || data_type == ImGuiDataType_U64) + return ImFormatString(buf, buf_size, format, *(const ImU64*)p_data); + if (data_type == ImGuiDataType_Float) + return ImFormatString(buf, buf_size, format, *(const float*)p_data); + if (data_type == ImGuiDataType_Double) + return ImFormatString(buf, buf_size, format, *(const double*)p_data); + if (data_type == ImGuiDataType_S8) + return ImFormatString(buf, buf_size, format, *(const ImS8*)p_data); + if (data_type == ImGuiDataType_U8) + return ImFormatString(buf, buf_size, format, *(const ImU8*)p_data); + if (data_type == ImGuiDataType_S16) + return ImFormatString(buf, buf_size, format, *(const ImS16*)p_data); + if (data_type == ImGuiDataType_U16) + return ImFormatString(buf, buf_size, format, *(const ImU16*)p_data); + IM_ASSERT(0); + return 0; +} + +void ImGui::DataTypeApplyOp(ImGuiDataType data_type, int op, void* output, const void* arg1, const void* arg2) +{ + IM_ASSERT(op == '+' || op == '-'); + switch (data_type) + { + case ImGuiDataType_S8: + if (op == '+') { *(ImS8*)output = ImAddClampOverflow(*(const ImS8*)arg1, *(const ImS8*)arg2, IM_S8_MIN, IM_S8_MAX); } + if (op == '-') { *(ImS8*)output = ImSubClampOverflow(*(const ImS8*)arg1, *(const ImS8*)arg2, IM_S8_MIN, IM_S8_MAX); } + return; + case ImGuiDataType_U8: + if (op == '+') { *(ImU8*)output = ImAddClampOverflow(*(const ImU8*)arg1, *(const ImU8*)arg2, IM_U8_MIN, IM_U8_MAX); } + if (op == '-') { *(ImU8*)output = ImSubClampOverflow(*(const ImU8*)arg1, *(const ImU8*)arg2, IM_U8_MIN, IM_U8_MAX); } + return; + case ImGuiDataType_S16: + if (op == '+') { *(ImS16*)output = ImAddClampOverflow(*(const ImS16*)arg1, *(const ImS16*)arg2, IM_S16_MIN, IM_S16_MAX); } + if (op == '-') { *(ImS16*)output = ImSubClampOverflow(*(const ImS16*)arg1, *(const ImS16*)arg2, IM_S16_MIN, IM_S16_MAX); } + return; + case ImGuiDataType_U16: + if (op == '+') { *(ImU16*)output = ImAddClampOverflow(*(const ImU16*)arg1, *(const ImU16*)arg2, IM_U16_MIN, IM_U16_MAX); } + if (op == '-') { *(ImU16*)output = ImSubClampOverflow(*(const ImU16*)arg1, *(const ImU16*)arg2, IM_U16_MIN, IM_U16_MAX); } + return; + case ImGuiDataType_S32: + if (op == '+') { *(ImS32*)output = ImAddClampOverflow(*(const ImS32*)arg1, *(const ImS32*)arg2, IM_S32_MIN, IM_S32_MAX); } + if (op == '-') { *(ImS32*)output = ImSubClampOverflow(*(const ImS32*)arg1, *(const ImS32*)arg2, IM_S32_MIN, IM_S32_MAX); } + return; + case ImGuiDataType_U32: + if (op == '+') { *(ImU32*)output = ImAddClampOverflow(*(const ImU32*)arg1, *(const ImU32*)arg2, IM_U32_MIN, IM_U32_MAX); } + if (op == '-') { *(ImU32*)output = ImSubClampOverflow(*(const ImU32*)arg1, *(const ImU32*)arg2, IM_U32_MIN, IM_U32_MAX); } + return; + case ImGuiDataType_S64: + if (op == '+') { *(ImS64*)output = ImAddClampOverflow(*(const ImS64*)arg1, *(const ImS64*)arg2, IM_S64_MIN, IM_S64_MAX); } + if (op == '-') { *(ImS64*)output = ImSubClampOverflow(*(const ImS64*)arg1, *(const ImS64*)arg2, IM_S64_MIN, IM_S64_MAX); } + return; + case ImGuiDataType_U64: + if (op == '+') { *(ImU64*)output = ImAddClampOverflow(*(const ImU64*)arg1, *(const ImU64*)arg2, IM_U64_MIN, IM_U64_MAX); } + if (op == '-') { *(ImU64*)output = ImSubClampOverflow(*(const ImU64*)arg1, *(const ImU64*)arg2, IM_U64_MIN, IM_U64_MAX); } + return; + case ImGuiDataType_Float: + if (op == '+') { *(float*)output = *(const float*)arg1 + *(const float*)arg2; } + if (op == '-') { *(float*)output = *(const float*)arg1 - *(const float*)arg2; } + return; + case ImGuiDataType_Double: + if (op == '+') { *(double*)output = *(const double*)arg1 + *(const double*)arg2; } + if (op == '-') { *(double*)output = *(const double*)arg1 - *(const double*)arg2; } + return; + case ImGuiDataType_COUNT: break; + } + IM_ASSERT(0); +} + +// User can input math operators (e.g. +100) to edit a numerical values. +// NB: This is _not_ a full expression evaluator. We should probably add one and replace this dumb mess.. +bool ImGui::DataTypeApplyOpFromText(const char* buf, const char* initial_value_buf, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* p_data, const char* format) +{ + while (ImCharIsBlankA(*buf)) + buf++; + + // We don't support '-' op because it would conflict with inputing negative value. + // Instead you can use +-100 to subtract from an existing value + char op = buf[0]; + if (op == '+' || op == '*' || op == '/') + { + buf++; + while (ImCharIsBlankA(*buf)) + buf++; + } + else + { + op = 0; + } + if (!buf[0]) + return false; + + // Copy the value in an opaque buffer so we can compare at the end of the function if it changed at all. + const ImGuiDataTypeInfo* type_info = DataTypeGetInfo(data_type); + ImGuiDataTypeTempStorage data_backup; + memcpy(&data_backup, p_data, type_info->Size); + + if (format == NULL) + format = type_info->ScanFmt; + + // FIXME-LEGACY: The aim is to remove those operators and write a proper expression evaluator at some point.. + int arg1i = 0; + if (data_type == ImGuiDataType_S32) + { + int* v = (int*)p_data; + int arg0i = *v; + float arg1f = 0.0f; + if (op && sscanf(initial_value_buf, format, &arg0i) < 1) + return false; + // Store operand in a float so we can use fractional value for multipliers (*1.1), but constant always parsed as integer so we can fit big integers (e.g. 2000000003) past float precision + if (op == '+') { if (sscanf(buf, "%d", &arg1i)) *v = (int)(arg0i + arg1i); } // Add (use "+-" to subtract) + else if (op == '*') { if (sscanf(buf, "%f", &arg1f)) *v = (int)(arg0i * arg1f); } // Multiply + else if (op == '/') { if (sscanf(buf, "%f", &arg1f) && arg1f != 0.0f) *v = (int)(arg0i / arg1f); } // Divide + else { if (sscanf(buf, format, &arg1i) == 1) *v = arg1i; } // Assign constant + } + else if (data_type == ImGuiDataType_Float) + { + // For floats we have to ignore format with precision (e.g. "%.2f") because sscanf doesn't take them in + format = "%f"; + float* v = (float*)p_data; + float arg0f = *v, arg1f = 0.0f; + if (op && sscanf(initial_value_buf, format, &arg0f) < 1) + return false; + if (sscanf(buf, format, &arg1f) < 1) + return false; + if (op == '+') { *v = arg0f + arg1f; } // Add (use "+-" to subtract) + else if (op == '*') { *v = arg0f * arg1f; } // Multiply + else if (op == '/') { if (arg1f != 0.0f) *v = arg0f / arg1f; } // Divide + else { *v = arg1f; } // Assign constant + } + else if (data_type == ImGuiDataType_Double) + { + format = "%lf"; // scanf differentiate float/double unlike printf which forces everything to double because of ellipsis + double* v = (double*)p_data; + double arg0f = *v, arg1f = 0.0; + if (op && sscanf(initial_value_buf, format, &arg0f) < 1) + return false; + if (sscanf(buf, format, &arg1f) < 1) + return false; + if (op == '+') { *v = arg0f + arg1f; } // Add (use "+-" to subtract) + else if (op == '*') { *v = arg0f * arg1f; } // Multiply + else if (op == '/') { if (arg1f != 0.0f) *v = arg0f / arg1f; } // Divide + else { *v = arg1f; } // Assign constant + } + else if (data_type == ImGuiDataType_U32 || data_type == ImGuiDataType_S64 || data_type == ImGuiDataType_U64) + { + // All other types assign constant + // We don't bother handling support for legacy operators since they are a little too crappy. Instead we will later implement a proper expression evaluator in the future. + if (sscanf(buf, format, p_data) < 1) + return false; + } + else + { + // Small types need a 32-bit buffer to receive the result from scanf() + int v32; + if (sscanf(buf, format, &v32) < 1) + return false; + if (data_type == ImGuiDataType_S8) + *(ImS8*)p_data = (ImS8)ImClamp(v32, (int)IM_S8_MIN, (int)IM_S8_MAX); + else if (data_type == ImGuiDataType_U8) + *(ImU8*)p_data = (ImU8)ImClamp(v32, (int)IM_U8_MIN, (int)IM_U8_MAX); + else if (data_type == ImGuiDataType_S16) + *(ImS16*)p_data = (ImS16)ImClamp(v32, (int)IM_S16_MIN, (int)IM_S16_MAX); + else if (data_type == ImGuiDataType_U16) + *(ImU16*)p_data = (ImU16)ImClamp(v32, (int)IM_U16_MIN, (int)IM_U16_MAX); + else + IM_ASSERT(0); + } + + return memcmp(&data_backup, p_data, type_info->Size) != 0; +} + +template +static int DataTypeCompareT(const T* lhs, const T* rhs) +{ + if (*lhs < *rhs) return -1; + if (*lhs > *rhs) return +1; + return 0; +} + +int ImGui::DataTypeCompare(ImGuiDataType data_type, const void* arg_1, const void* arg_2) +{ + switch (data_type) + { + case ImGuiDataType_S8: return DataTypeCompareT((const ImS8* )arg_1, (const ImS8* )arg_2); + case ImGuiDataType_U8: return DataTypeCompareT((const ImU8* )arg_1, (const ImU8* )arg_2); + case ImGuiDataType_S16: return DataTypeCompareT((const ImS16* )arg_1, (const ImS16* )arg_2); + case ImGuiDataType_U16: return DataTypeCompareT((const ImU16* )arg_1, (const ImU16* )arg_2); + case ImGuiDataType_S32: return DataTypeCompareT((const ImS32* )arg_1, (const ImS32* )arg_2); + case ImGuiDataType_U32: return DataTypeCompareT((const ImU32* )arg_1, (const ImU32* )arg_2); + case ImGuiDataType_S64: return DataTypeCompareT((const ImS64* )arg_1, (const ImS64* )arg_2); + case ImGuiDataType_U64: return DataTypeCompareT((const ImU64* )arg_1, (const ImU64* )arg_2); + case ImGuiDataType_Float: return DataTypeCompareT((const float* )arg_1, (const float* )arg_2); + case ImGuiDataType_Double: return DataTypeCompareT((const double*)arg_1, (const double*)arg_2); + case ImGuiDataType_COUNT: break; + } + IM_ASSERT(0); + return 0; +} + +template +static bool DataTypeClampT(T* v, const T* v_min, const T* v_max) +{ + // Clamp, both sides are optional, return true if modified + if (v_min && *v < *v_min) { *v = *v_min; return true; } + if (v_max && *v > *v_max) { *v = *v_max; return true; } + return false; +} + +bool ImGui::DataTypeClamp(ImGuiDataType data_type, void* p_data, const void* p_min, const void* p_max) +{ + switch (data_type) + { + case ImGuiDataType_S8: return DataTypeClampT((ImS8* )p_data, (const ImS8* )p_min, (const ImS8* )p_max); + case ImGuiDataType_U8: return DataTypeClampT((ImU8* )p_data, (const ImU8* )p_min, (const ImU8* )p_max); + case ImGuiDataType_S16: return DataTypeClampT((ImS16* )p_data, (const ImS16* )p_min, (const ImS16* )p_max); + case ImGuiDataType_U16: return DataTypeClampT((ImU16* )p_data, (const ImU16* )p_min, (const ImU16* )p_max); + case ImGuiDataType_S32: return DataTypeClampT((ImS32* )p_data, (const ImS32* )p_min, (const ImS32* )p_max); + case ImGuiDataType_U32: return DataTypeClampT((ImU32* )p_data, (const ImU32* )p_min, (const ImU32* )p_max); + case ImGuiDataType_S64: return DataTypeClampT((ImS64* )p_data, (const ImS64* )p_min, (const ImS64* )p_max); + case ImGuiDataType_U64: return DataTypeClampT((ImU64* )p_data, (const ImU64* )p_min, (const ImU64* )p_max); + case ImGuiDataType_Float: return DataTypeClampT((float* )p_data, (const float* )p_min, (const float* )p_max); + case ImGuiDataType_Double: return DataTypeClampT((double*)p_data, (const double*)p_min, (const double*)p_max); + case ImGuiDataType_COUNT: break; + } + IM_ASSERT(0); + return false; +} + +static float GetMinimumStepAtDecimalPrecision(int decimal_precision) +{ + static const float min_steps[10] = { 1.0f, 0.1f, 0.01f, 0.001f, 0.0001f, 0.00001f, 0.000001f, 0.0000001f, 0.00000001f, 0.000000001f }; + if (decimal_precision < 0) + return FLT_MIN; + return (decimal_precision < IM_ARRAYSIZE(min_steps)) ? min_steps[decimal_precision] : ImPow(10.0f, (float)-decimal_precision); +} + +template +static const char* ImAtoi(const char* src, TYPE* output) +{ + int negative = 0; + if (*src == '-') { negative = 1; src++; } + if (*src == '+') { src++; } + TYPE v = 0; + while (*src >= '0' && *src <= '9') + v = (v * 10) + (*src++ - '0'); + *output = negative ? -v : v; + return src; +} + +// Sanitize format +// - Zero terminate so extra characters after format (e.g. "%f123") don't confuse atof/atoi +// - stb_sprintf.h supports several new modifiers which format numbers in a way that also makes them incompatible atof/atoi. +static void SanitizeFormatString(const char* fmt, char* fmt_out, size_t fmt_out_size) +{ + IM_UNUSED(fmt_out_size); + const char* fmt_end = ImParseFormatFindEnd(fmt); + IM_ASSERT((size_t)(fmt_end - fmt + 1) < fmt_out_size); // Format is too long, let us know if this happens to you! + while (fmt < fmt_end) + { + char c = *(fmt++); + if (c != '\'' && c != '$' && c != '_') // Custom flags provided by stb_sprintf.h. POSIX 2008 also supports '. + *(fmt_out++) = c; + } + *fmt_out = 0; // Zero-terminate +} + +template +TYPE ImGui::RoundScalarWithFormatT(const char* format, ImGuiDataType data_type, TYPE v) +{ + const char* fmt_start = ImParseFormatFindStart(format); + if (fmt_start[0] != '%' || fmt_start[1] == '%') // Don't apply if the value is not visible in the format string + return v; + + // Sanitize format + char fmt_sanitized[32]; + SanitizeFormatString(fmt_start, fmt_sanitized, IM_ARRAYSIZE(fmt_sanitized)); + fmt_start = fmt_sanitized; + + // Format value with our rounding, and read back + char v_str[64]; + ImFormatString(v_str, IM_ARRAYSIZE(v_str), fmt_start, v); + const char* p = v_str; + while (*p == ' ') + p++; + if (data_type == ImGuiDataType_Float || data_type == ImGuiDataType_Double) + v = (TYPE)ImAtof(p); + else + ImAtoi(p, (SIGNEDTYPE*)&v); + return v; +} + +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Widgets: DragScalar, DragFloat, DragInt, etc. +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// - DragBehaviorT<>() [Internal] +// - DragBehavior() [Internal] +// - DragScalar() +// - DragScalarN() +// - DragFloat() +// - DragFloat2() +// - DragFloat3() +// - DragFloat4() +// - DragFloatRange2() +// - DragInt() +// - DragInt2() +// - DragInt3() +// - DragInt4() +// - DragIntRange2() +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// This is called by DragBehavior() when the widget is active (held by mouse or being manipulated with Nav controls) +template +bool ImGui::DragBehaviorT(ImGuiDataType data_type, TYPE* v, float v_speed, const TYPE v_min, const TYPE v_max, const char* format, ImGuiSliderFlags flags) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + const ImGuiAxis axis = (flags & ImGuiSliderFlags_Vertical) ? ImGuiAxis_Y : ImGuiAxis_X; + const bool is_clamped = (v_min < v_max); + const bool is_logarithmic = (flags & ImGuiSliderFlags_Logarithmic) != 0; + const bool is_floating_point = (data_type == ImGuiDataType_Float) || (data_type == ImGuiDataType_Double); + + // Default tweak speed + if (v_speed == 0.0f && is_clamped && (v_max - v_min < FLT_MAX)) + v_speed = (float)((v_max - v_min) * g.DragSpeedDefaultRatio); + + // Inputs accumulates into g.DragCurrentAccum, which is flushed into the current value as soon as it makes a difference with our precision settings + float adjust_delta = 0.0f; + if (g.ActiveIdSource == ImGuiInputSource_Mouse && IsMousePosValid() && IsMouseDragPastThreshold(0, g.IO.MouseDragThreshold * DRAG_MOUSE_THRESHOLD_FACTOR)) + { + adjust_delta = g.IO.MouseDelta[axis]; + if (g.IO.KeyAlt) + adjust_delta *= 1.0f / 100.0f; + if (g.IO.KeyShift) + adjust_delta *= 10.0f; + } + else if (g.ActiveIdSource == ImGuiInputSource_Nav) + { + const int decimal_precision = is_floating_point ? ImParseFormatPrecision(format, 3) : 0; + adjust_delta = GetNavInputAmount2d(ImGuiNavDirSourceFlags_Keyboard | ImGuiNavDirSourceFlags_PadDPad, ImGuiInputReadMode_RepeatFast, 1.0f / 10.0f, 10.0f)[axis]; + v_speed = ImMax(v_speed, GetMinimumStepAtDecimalPrecision(decimal_precision)); + } + adjust_delta *= v_speed; + + // For vertical drag we currently assume that Up=higher value (like we do with vertical sliders). This may become a parameter. + if (axis == ImGuiAxis_Y) + adjust_delta = -adjust_delta; + + // For logarithmic use our range is effectively 0..1 so scale the delta into that range + if (is_logarithmic && (v_max - v_min < FLT_MAX) && ((v_max - v_min) > 0.000001f)) // Epsilon to avoid /0 + adjust_delta /= (float)(v_max - v_min); + + // Clear current value on activation + // Avoid altering values and clamping when we are _already_ past the limits and heading in the same direction, so e.g. if range is 0..255, current value is 300 and we are pushing to the right side, keep the 300. + bool is_just_activated = g.ActiveIdIsJustActivated; + bool is_already_past_limits_and_pushing_outward = is_clamped && ((*v >= v_max && adjust_delta > 0.0f) || (*v <= v_min && adjust_delta < 0.0f)); + if (is_just_activated || is_already_past_limits_and_pushing_outward) + { + g.DragCurrentAccum = 0.0f; + g.DragCurrentAccumDirty = false; + } + else if (adjust_delta != 0.0f) + { + g.DragCurrentAccum += adjust_delta; + g.DragCurrentAccumDirty = true; + } + + if (!g.DragCurrentAccumDirty) + return false; + + TYPE v_cur = *v; + FLOATTYPE v_old_ref_for_accum_remainder = (FLOATTYPE)0.0f; + + float logarithmic_zero_epsilon = 0.0f; // Only valid when is_logarithmic is true + const float zero_deadzone_halfsize = 0.0f; // Drag widgets have no deadzone (as it doesn't make sense) + if (is_logarithmic) + { + // When using logarithmic sliders, we need to clamp to avoid hitting zero, but our choice of clamp value greatly affects slider precision. We attempt to use the specified precision to estimate a good lower bound. + const int decimal_precision = is_floating_point ? ImParseFormatPrecision(format, 3) : 1; + logarithmic_zero_epsilon = ImPow(0.1f, (float)decimal_precision); + + // Convert to parametric space, apply delta, convert back + float v_old_parametric = ScaleRatioFromValueT(data_type, v_cur, v_min, v_max, is_logarithmic, logarithmic_zero_epsilon, zero_deadzone_halfsize); + float v_new_parametric = v_old_parametric + g.DragCurrentAccum; + v_cur = ScaleValueFromRatioT(data_type, v_new_parametric, v_min, v_max, is_logarithmic, logarithmic_zero_epsilon, zero_deadzone_halfsize); + v_old_ref_for_accum_remainder = v_old_parametric; + } + else + { + v_cur += (SIGNEDTYPE)g.DragCurrentAccum; + } + + // Round to user desired precision based on format string + if (!(flags & ImGuiSliderFlags_NoRoundToFormat)) + v_cur = RoundScalarWithFormatT(format, data_type, v_cur); + + // Preserve remainder after rounding has been applied. This also allow slow tweaking of values. + g.DragCurrentAccumDirty = false; + if (is_logarithmic) + { + // Convert to parametric space, apply delta, convert back + float v_new_parametric = ScaleRatioFromValueT(data_type, v_cur, v_min, v_max, is_logarithmic, logarithmic_zero_epsilon, zero_deadzone_halfsize); + g.DragCurrentAccum -= (float)(v_new_parametric - v_old_ref_for_accum_remainder); + } + else + { + g.DragCurrentAccum -= (float)((SIGNEDTYPE)v_cur - (SIGNEDTYPE)*v); + } + + // Lose zero sign for float/double + if (v_cur == (TYPE)-0) + v_cur = (TYPE)0; + + // Clamp values (+ handle overflow/wrap-around for integer types) + if (*v != v_cur && is_clamped) + { + if (v_cur < v_min || (v_cur > *v && adjust_delta < 0.0f && !is_floating_point)) + v_cur = v_min; + if (v_cur > v_max || (v_cur < *v && adjust_delta > 0.0f && !is_floating_point)) + v_cur = v_max; + } + + // Apply result + if (*v == v_cur) + return false; + *v = v_cur; + return true; +} + +bool ImGui::DragBehavior(ImGuiID id, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* p_v, float v_speed, const void* p_min, const void* p_max, const char* format, ImGuiSliderFlags flags) +{ + // Read imgui.cpp "API BREAKING CHANGES" section for 1.78 if you hit this assert. + IM_ASSERT((flags == 1 || (flags & ImGuiSliderFlags_InvalidMask_) == 0) && "Invalid ImGuiSliderFlags flags! Has the 'float power' argument been mistakenly cast to flags? Call function with ImGuiSliderFlags_Logarithmic flags instead."); + + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + if (g.ActiveId == id) + { + if (g.ActiveIdSource == ImGuiInputSource_Mouse && !g.IO.MouseDown[0]) + ClearActiveID(); + else if (g.ActiveIdSource == ImGuiInputSource_Nav && g.NavActivatePressedId == id && !g.ActiveIdIsJustActivated) + ClearActiveID(); + } + if (g.ActiveId != id) + return false; + if ((g.LastItemData.InFlags & ImGuiItemFlags_ReadOnly) || (flags & ImGuiSliderFlags_ReadOnly)) + return false; + + switch (data_type) + { + case ImGuiDataType_S8: { ImS32 v32 = (ImS32)*(ImS8*)p_v; bool r = DragBehaviorT(ImGuiDataType_S32, &v32, v_speed, p_min ? *(const ImS8*) p_min : IM_S8_MIN, p_max ? *(const ImS8*)p_max : IM_S8_MAX, format, flags); if (r) *(ImS8*)p_v = (ImS8)v32; return r; } + case ImGuiDataType_U8: { ImU32 v32 = (ImU32)*(ImU8*)p_v; bool r = DragBehaviorT(ImGuiDataType_U32, &v32, v_speed, p_min ? *(const ImU8*) p_min : IM_U8_MIN, p_max ? *(const ImU8*)p_max : IM_U8_MAX, format, flags); if (r) *(ImU8*)p_v = (ImU8)v32; return r; } + case ImGuiDataType_S16: { ImS32 v32 = (ImS32)*(ImS16*)p_v; bool r = DragBehaviorT(ImGuiDataType_S32, &v32, v_speed, p_min ? *(const ImS16*)p_min : IM_S16_MIN, p_max ? *(const ImS16*)p_max : IM_S16_MAX, format, flags); if (r) *(ImS16*)p_v = (ImS16)v32; return r; } + case ImGuiDataType_U16: { ImU32 v32 = (ImU32)*(ImU16*)p_v; bool r = DragBehaviorT(ImGuiDataType_U32, &v32, v_speed, p_min ? *(const ImU16*)p_min : IM_U16_MIN, p_max ? *(const ImU16*)p_max : IM_U16_MAX, format, flags); if (r) *(ImU16*)p_v = (ImU16)v32; return r; } + case ImGuiDataType_S32: return DragBehaviorT(data_type, (ImS32*)p_v, v_speed, p_min ? *(const ImS32* )p_min : IM_S32_MIN, p_max ? *(const ImS32* )p_max : IM_S32_MAX, format, flags); + case ImGuiDataType_U32: return DragBehaviorT(data_type, (ImU32*)p_v, v_speed, p_min ? *(const ImU32* )p_min : IM_U32_MIN, p_max ? *(const ImU32* )p_max : IM_U32_MAX, format, flags); + case ImGuiDataType_S64: return DragBehaviorT(data_type, (ImS64*)p_v, v_speed, p_min ? *(const ImS64* )p_min : IM_S64_MIN, p_max ? *(const ImS64* )p_max : IM_S64_MAX, format, flags); + case ImGuiDataType_U64: return DragBehaviorT(data_type, (ImU64*)p_v, v_speed, p_min ? *(const ImU64* )p_min : IM_U64_MIN, p_max ? *(const ImU64* )p_max : IM_U64_MAX, format, flags); + case ImGuiDataType_Float: return DragBehaviorT(data_type, (float*)p_v, v_speed, p_min ? *(const float* )p_min : -FLT_MAX, p_max ? *(const float* )p_max : FLT_MAX, format, flags); + case ImGuiDataType_Double: return DragBehaviorT(data_type, (double*)p_v, v_speed, p_min ? *(const double*)p_min : -DBL_MAX, p_max ? *(const double*)p_max : DBL_MAX, format, flags); + case ImGuiDataType_COUNT: break; + } + IM_ASSERT(0); + return false; +} + +// Note: p_data, p_min and p_max are _pointers_ to a memory address holding the data. For a Drag widget, p_min and p_max are optional. +// Read code of e.g. DragFloat(), DragInt() etc. or examples in 'Demo->Widgets->Data Types' to understand how to use this function directly. +bool ImGui::DragScalar(const char* label, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* p_data, float v_speed, const void* p_min, const void* p_max, const char* format, ImGuiSliderFlags flags) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + if (window->SkipItems) + return false; + + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style; + const ImGuiID id = window->GetID(label); + const float w = CalcItemWidth(); + + const ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true); + const ImRect frame_bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + ImVec2(w, label_size.y + style.FramePadding.y * 2.0f)); + const ImRect total_bb(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max + ImVec2(label_size.x > 0.0f ? style.ItemInnerSpacing.x + label_size.x : 0.0f, 0.0f)); + + const bool temp_input_allowed = (flags & ImGuiSliderFlags_NoInput) == 0; + ItemSize(total_bb, style.FramePadding.y); + if (!ItemAdd(total_bb, id, &frame_bb, temp_input_allowed ? ImGuiItemAddFlags_Focusable : 0)) + return false; + + // Default format string when passing NULL + if (format == NULL) + format = DataTypeGetInfo(data_type)->PrintFmt; + else if (data_type == ImGuiDataType_S32 && strcmp(format, "%d") != 0) // (FIXME-LEGACY: Patch old "%.0f" format string to use "%d", read function more details.) + format = PatchFormatStringFloatToInt(format); + + // Tabbing or CTRL-clicking on Drag turns it into an InputText + const bool hovered = ItemHoverable(frame_bb, id); + bool temp_input_is_active = temp_input_allowed && TempInputIsActive(id); + if (!temp_input_is_active) + { + const bool focus_requested = temp_input_allowed && (g.LastItemData.StatusFlags & ImGuiItemStatusFlags_Focused) != 0; + const bool clicked = (hovered && g.IO.MouseClicked[0]); + const bool double_clicked = (hovered && g.IO.MouseDoubleClicked[0]); + if (focus_requested || clicked || double_clicked || g.NavActivateId == id || g.NavInputId == id) + { + SetActiveID(id, window); + SetFocusID(id, window); + FocusWindow(window); + g.ActiveIdUsingNavDirMask = (1 << ImGuiDir_Left) | (1 << ImGuiDir_Right); + if (temp_input_allowed && (focus_requested || (clicked && g.IO.KeyCtrl) || double_clicked || g.NavInputId == id)) + temp_input_is_active = true; + } + // Experimental: simple click (without moving) turns Drag into an InputText + // FIXME: Currently polling ImGuiConfigFlags_IsTouchScreen, may either poll an hypothetical ImGuiBackendFlags_HasKeyboard and/or an explicit drag settings. + if (g.IO.ConfigDragClickToInputText && temp_input_allowed && !temp_input_is_active) + if (g.ActiveId == id && hovered && g.IO.MouseReleased[0] && !IsMouseDragPastThreshold(0, g.IO.MouseDragThreshold * DRAG_MOUSE_THRESHOLD_FACTOR)) + { + g.NavInputId = id; + temp_input_is_active = true; + } + } + + if (temp_input_is_active) + { + // Only clamp CTRL+Click input when ImGuiSliderFlags_AlwaysClamp is set + const bool is_clamp_input = (flags & ImGuiSliderFlags_AlwaysClamp) != 0 && (p_min == NULL || p_max == NULL || DataTypeCompare(data_type, p_min, p_max) < 0); + return TempInputScalar(frame_bb, id, label, data_type, p_data, format, is_clamp_input ? p_min : NULL, is_clamp_input ? p_max : NULL); + } + + // Draw frame + const ImU32 frame_col = GetColorU32(g.ActiveId == id ? ImGuiCol_FrameBgActive : hovered ? ImGuiCol_FrameBgHovered : ImGuiCol_FrameBg); + RenderNavHighlight(frame_bb, id); + RenderFrame(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max, frame_col, true, style.FrameRounding); + + // Drag behavior + const bool value_changed = DragBehavior(id, data_type, p_data, v_speed, p_min, p_max, format, flags); + if (value_changed) + MarkItemEdited(id); + + // Display value using user-provided display format so user can add prefix/suffix/decorations to the value. + char value_buf[64]; + const char* value_buf_end = value_buf + DataTypeFormatString(value_buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(value_buf), data_type, p_data, format); + if (g.LogEnabled) + LogSetNextTextDecoration("{", "}"); + RenderTextClipped(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max, value_buf, value_buf_end, NULL, ImVec2(0.5f, 0.5f)); + + if (label_size.x > 0.0f) + RenderText(ImVec2(frame_bb.Max.x + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x, frame_bb.Min.y + style.FramePadding.y), label); + + IMGUI_TEST_ENGINE_ITEM_INFO(id, label, g.LastItemData.StatusFlags); + return value_changed; +} + +bool ImGui::DragScalarN(const char* label, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* p_data, int components, float v_speed, const void* p_min, const void* p_max, const char* format, ImGuiSliderFlags flags) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + if (window->SkipItems) + return false; + + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + bool value_changed = false; + BeginGroup(); + PushID(label); + PushMultiItemsWidths(components, CalcItemWidth()); + size_t type_size = GDataTypeInfo[data_type].Size; + for (int i = 0; i < components; i++) + { + PushID(i); + if (i > 0) + SameLine(0, g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x); + value_changed |= DragScalar("", data_type, p_data, v_speed, p_min, p_max, format, flags); + PopID(); + PopItemWidth(); + p_data = (void*)((char*)p_data + type_size); + } + PopID(); + + const char* label_end = FindRenderedTextEnd(label); + if (label != label_end) + { + SameLine(0, g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x); + TextEx(label, label_end); + } + + EndGroup(); + return value_changed; +} + +bool ImGui::DragFloat(const char* label, float* v, float v_speed, float v_min, float v_max, const char* format, ImGuiSliderFlags flags) +{ + return DragScalar(label, ImGuiDataType_Float, v, v_speed, &v_min, &v_max, format, flags); +} + +bool ImGui::DragFloat2(const char* label, float v[2], float v_speed, float v_min, float v_max, const char* format, ImGuiSliderFlags flags) +{ + return DragScalarN(label, ImGuiDataType_Float, v, 2, v_speed, &v_min, &v_max, format, flags); +} + +bool ImGui::DragFloat3(const char* label, float v[3], float v_speed, float v_min, float v_max, const char* format, ImGuiSliderFlags flags) +{ + return DragScalarN(label, ImGuiDataType_Float, v, 3, v_speed, &v_min, &v_max, format, flags); +} + +bool ImGui::DragFloat4(const char* label, float v[4], float v_speed, float v_min, float v_max, const char* format, ImGuiSliderFlags flags) +{ + return DragScalarN(label, ImGuiDataType_Float, v, 4, v_speed, &v_min, &v_max, format, flags); +} + +// NB: You likely want to specify the ImGuiSliderFlags_AlwaysClamp when using this. +bool ImGui::DragFloatRange2(const char* label, float* v_current_min, float* v_current_max, float v_speed, float v_min, float v_max, const char* format, const char* format_max, ImGuiSliderFlags flags) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + if (window->SkipItems) + return false; + + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + PushID(label); + BeginGroup(); + PushMultiItemsWidths(2, CalcItemWidth()); + + float min_min = (v_min >= v_max) ? -FLT_MAX : v_min; + float min_max = (v_min >= v_max) ? *v_current_max : ImMin(v_max, *v_current_max); + ImGuiSliderFlags min_flags = flags | ((min_min == min_max) ? ImGuiSliderFlags_ReadOnly : 0); + bool value_changed = DragScalar("##min", ImGuiDataType_Float, v_current_min, v_speed, &min_min, &min_max, format, min_flags); + PopItemWidth(); + SameLine(0, g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x); + + float max_min = (v_min >= v_max) ? *v_current_min : ImMax(v_min, *v_current_min); + float max_max = (v_min >= v_max) ? FLT_MAX : v_max; + ImGuiSliderFlags max_flags = flags | ((max_min == max_max) ? ImGuiSliderFlags_ReadOnly : 0); + value_changed |= DragScalar("##max", ImGuiDataType_Float, v_current_max, v_speed, &max_min, &max_max, format_max ? format_max : format, max_flags); + PopItemWidth(); + SameLine(0, g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x); + + TextEx(label, FindRenderedTextEnd(label)); + EndGroup(); + PopID(); + + return value_changed; +} + +// NB: v_speed is float to allow adjusting the drag speed with more precision +bool ImGui::DragInt(const char* label, int* v, float v_speed, int v_min, int v_max, const char* format, ImGuiSliderFlags flags) +{ + return DragScalar(label, ImGuiDataType_S32, v, v_speed, &v_min, &v_max, format, flags); +} + +bool ImGui::DragInt2(const char* label, int v[2], float v_speed, int v_min, int v_max, const char* format, ImGuiSliderFlags flags) +{ + return DragScalarN(label, ImGuiDataType_S32, v, 2, v_speed, &v_min, &v_max, format, flags); +} + +bool ImGui::DragInt3(const char* label, int v[3], float v_speed, int v_min, int v_max, const char* format, ImGuiSliderFlags flags) +{ + return DragScalarN(label, ImGuiDataType_S32, v, 3, v_speed, &v_min, &v_max, format, flags); +} + +bool ImGui::DragInt4(const char* label, int v[4], float v_speed, int v_min, int v_max, const char* format, ImGuiSliderFlags flags) +{ + return DragScalarN(label, ImGuiDataType_S32, v, 4, v_speed, &v_min, &v_max, format, flags); +} + +// NB: You likely want to specify the ImGuiSliderFlags_AlwaysClamp when using this. +bool ImGui::DragIntRange2(const char* label, int* v_current_min, int* v_current_max, float v_speed, int v_min, int v_max, const char* format, const char* format_max, ImGuiSliderFlags flags) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + if (window->SkipItems) + return false; + + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + PushID(label); + BeginGroup(); + PushMultiItemsWidths(2, CalcItemWidth()); + + int min_min = (v_min >= v_max) ? INT_MIN : v_min; + int min_max = (v_min >= v_max) ? *v_current_max : ImMin(v_max, *v_current_max); + ImGuiSliderFlags min_flags = flags | ((min_min == min_max) ? ImGuiSliderFlags_ReadOnly : 0); + bool value_changed = DragInt("##min", v_current_min, v_speed, min_min, min_max, format, min_flags); + PopItemWidth(); + SameLine(0, g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x); + + int max_min = (v_min >= v_max) ? *v_current_min : ImMax(v_min, *v_current_min); + int max_max = (v_min >= v_max) ? INT_MAX : v_max; + ImGuiSliderFlags max_flags = flags | ((max_min == max_max) ? ImGuiSliderFlags_ReadOnly : 0); + value_changed |= DragInt("##max", v_current_max, v_speed, max_min, max_max, format_max ? format_max : format, max_flags); + PopItemWidth(); + SameLine(0, g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x); + + TextEx(label, FindRenderedTextEnd(label)); + EndGroup(); + PopID(); + + return value_changed; +} + +#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_OBSOLETE_FUNCTIONS + +// Obsolete versions with power parameter. See https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/issues/3361 for details. +bool ImGui::DragScalar(const char* label, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* p_data, float v_speed, const void* p_min, const void* p_max, const char* format, float power) +{ + ImGuiSliderFlags drag_flags = ImGuiSliderFlags_None; + if (power != 1.0f) + { + IM_ASSERT(power == 1.0f && "Call function with ImGuiSliderFlags_Logarithmic flags instead of using the old 'float power' function!"); + IM_ASSERT(p_min != NULL && p_max != NULL); // When using a power curve the drag needs to have known bounds + drag_flags |= ImGuiSliderFlags_Logarithmic; // Fallback for non-asserting paths + } + return DragScalar(label, data_type, p_data, v_speed, p_min, p_max, format, drag_flags); +} + +bool ImGui::DragScalarN(const char* label, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* p_data, int components, float v_speed, const void* p_min, const void* p_max, const char* format, float power) +{ + ImGuiSliderFlags drag_flags = ImGuiSliderFlags_None; + if (power != 1.0f) + { + IM_ASSERT(power == 1.0f && "Call function with ImGuiSliderFlags_Logarithmic flags instead of using the old 'float power' function!"); + IM_ASSERT(p_min != NULL && p_max != NULL); // When using a power curve the drag needs to have known bounds + drag_flags |= ImGuiSliderFlags_Logarithmic; // Fallback for non-asserting paths + } + return DragScalarN(label, data_type, p_data, components, v_speed, p_min, p_max, format, drag_flags); +} + +#endif // IMGUI_DISABLE_OBSOLETE_FUNCTIONS + +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Widgets: SliderScalar, SliderFloat, SliderInt, etc. +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// - ScaleRatioFromValueT<> [Internal] +// - ScaleValueFromRatioT<> [Internal] +// - SliderBehaviorT<>() [Internal] +// - SliderBehavior() [Internal] +// - SliderScalar() +// - SliderScalarN() +// - SliderFloat() +// - SliderFloat2() +// - SliderFloat3() +// - SliderFloat4() +// - SliderAngle() +// - SliderInt() +// - SliderInt2() +// - SliderInt3() +// - SliderInt4() +// - VSliderScalar() +// - VSliderFloat() +// - VSliderInt() +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// Convert a value v in the output space of a slider into a parametric position on the slider itself (the logical opposite of ScaleValueFromRatioT) +template +float ImGui::ScaleRatioFromValueT(ImGuiDataType data_type, TYPE v, TYPE v_min, TYPE v_max, bool is_logarithmic, float logarithmic_zero_epsilon, float zero_deadzone_halfsize) +{ + if (v_min == v_max) + return 0.0f; + IM_UNUSED(data_type); + + const TYPE v_clamped = (v_min < v_max) ? ImClamp(v, v_min, v_max) : ImClamp(v, v_max, v_min); + if (is_logarithmic) + { + bool flipped = v_max < v_min; + + if (flipped) // Handle the case where the range is backwards + ImSwap(v_min, v_max); + + // Fudge min/max to avoid getting close to log(0) + FLOATTYPE v_min_fudged = (ImAbs((FLOATTYPE)v_min) < logarithmic_zero_epsilon) ? ((v_min < 0.0f) ? -logarithmic_zero_epsilon : logarithmic_zero_epsilon) : (FLOATTYPE)v_min; + FLOATTYPE v_max_fudged = (ImAbs((FLOATTYPE)v_max) < logarithmic_zero_epsilon) ? ((v_max < 0.0f) ? -logarithmic_zero_epsilon : logarithmic_zero_epsilon) : (FLOATTYPE)v_max; + + // Awkward special cases - we need ranges of the form (-100 .. 0) to convert to (-100 .. -epsilon), not (-100 .. epsilon) + if ((v_min == 0.0f) && (v_max < 0.0f)) + v_min_fudged = -logarithmic_zero_epsilon; + else if ((v_max == 0.0f) && (v_min < 0.0f)) + v_max_fudged = -logarithmic_zero_epsilon; + + float result; + + if (v_clamped <= v_min_fudged) + result = 0.0f; // Workaround for values that are in-range but below our fudge + else if (v_clamped >= v_max_fudged) + result = 1.0f; // Workaround for values that are in-range but above our fudge + else if ((v_min * v_max) < 0.0f) // Range crosses zero, so split into two portions + { + float zero_point_center = (-(float)v_min) / ((float)v_max - (float)v_min); // The zero point in parametric space. There's an argument we should take the logarithmic nature into account when calculating this, but for now this should do (and the most common case of a symmetrical range works fine) + float zero_point_snap_L = zero_point_center - zero_deadzone_halfsize; + float zero_point_snap_R = zero_point_center + zero_deadzone_halfsize; + if (v == 0.0f) + result = zero_point_center; // Special case for exactly zero + else if (v < 0.0f) + result = (1.0f - (float)(ImLog(-(FLOATTYPE)v_clamped / logarithmic_zero_epsilon) / ImLog(-v_min_fudged / logarithmic_zero_epsilon))) * zero_point_snap_L; + else + result = zero_point_snap_R + ((float)(ImLog((FLOATTYPE)v_clamped / logarithmic_zero_epsilon) / ImLog(v_max_fudged / logarithmic_zero_epsilon)) * (1.0f - zero_point_snap_R)); + } + else if ((v_min < 0.0f) || (v_max < 0.0f)) // Entirely negative slider + result = 1.0f - (float)(ImLog(-(FLOATTYPE)v_clamped / -v_max_fudged) / ImLog(-v_min_fudged / -v_max_fudged)); + else + result = (float)(ImLog((FLOATTYPE)v_clamped / v_min_fudged) / ImLog(v_max_fudged / v_min_fudged)); + + return flipped ? (1.0f - result) : result; + } + + // Linear slider + return (float)((FLOATTYPE)(SIGNEDTYPE)(v_clamped - v_min) / (FLOATTYPE)(SIGNEDTYPE)(v_max - v_min)); +} + +// Convert a parametric position on a slider into a value v in the output space (the logical opposite of ScaleRatioFromValueT) +template +TYPE ImGui::ScaleValueFromRatioT(ImGuiDataType data_type, float t, TYPE v_min, TYPE v_max, bool is_logarithmic, float logarithmic_zero_epsilon, float zero_deadzone_halfsize) +{ + if (v_min == v_max) + return v_min; + const bool is_floating_point = (data_type == ImGuiDataType_Float) || (data_type == ImGuiDataType_Double); + + TYPE result; + if (is_logarithmic) + { + // We special-case the extents because otherwise our fudging can lead to "mathematically correct" but non-intuitive behaviors like a fully-left slider not actually reaching the minimum value + if (t <= 0.0f) + result = v_min; + else if (t >= 1.0f) + result = v_max; + else + { + bool flipped = v_max < v_min; // Check if range is "backwards" + + // Fudge min/max to avoid getting silly results close to zero + FLOATTYPE v_min_fudged = (ImAbs((FLOATTYPE)v_min) < logarithmic_zero_epsilon) ? ((v_min < 0.0f) ? -logarithmic_zero_epsilon : logarithmic_zero_epsilon) : (FLOATTYPE)v_min; + FLOATTYPE v_max_fudged = (ImAbs((FLOATTYPE)v_max) < logarithmic_zero_epsilon) ? ((v_max < 0.0f) ? -logarithmic_zero_epsilon : logarithmic_zero_epsilon) : (FLOATTYPE)v_max; + + if (flipped) + ImSwap(v_min_fudged, v_max_fudged); + + // Awkward special case - we need ranges of the form (-100 .. 0) to convert to (-100 .. -epsilon), not (-100 .. epsilon) + if ((v_max == 0.0f) && (v_min < 0.0f)) + v_max_fudged = -logarithmic_zero_epsilon; + + float t_with_flip = flipped ? (1.0f - t) : t; // t, but flipped if necessary to account for us flipping the range + + if ((v_min * v_max) < 0.0f) // Range crosses zero, so we have to do this in two parts + { + float zero_point_center = (-(float)ImMin(v_min, v_max)) / ImAbs((float)v_max - (float)v_min); // The zero point in parametric space + float zero_point_snap_L = zero_point_center - zero_deadzone_halfsize; + float zero_point_snap_R = zero_point_center + zero_deadzone_halfsize; + if (t_with_flip >= zero_point_snap_L && t_with_flip <= zero_point_snap_R) + result = (TYPE)0.0f; // Special case to make getting exactly zero possible (the epsilon prevents it otherwise) + else if (t_with_flip < zero_point_center) + result = (TYPE)-(logarithmic_zero_epsilon * ImPow(-v_min_fudged / logarithmic_zero_epsilon, (FLOATTYPE)(1.0f - (t_with_flip / zero_point_snap_L)))); + else + result = (TYPE)(logarithmic_zero_epsilon * ImPow(v_max_fudged / logarithmic_zero_epsilon, (FLOATTYPE)((t_with_flip - zero_point_snap_R) / (1.0f - zero_point_snap_R)))); + } + else if ((v_min < 0.0f) || (v_max < 0.0f)) // Entirely negative slider + result = (TYPE)-(-v_max_fudged * ImPow(-v_min_fudged / -v_max_fudged, (FLOATTYPE)(1.0f - t_with_flip))); + else + result = (TYPE)(v_min_fudged * ImPow(v_max_fudged / v_min_fudged, (FLOATTYPE)t_with_flip)); + } + } + else + { + // Linear slider + if (is_floating_point) + { + result = ImLerp(v_min, v_max, t); + } + else + { + // - For integer values we want the clicking position to match the grab box so we round above + // This code is carefully tuned to work with large values (e.g. high ranges of U64) while preserving this property.. + // - Not doing a *1.0 multiply at the end of a range as it tends to be lossy. While absolute aiming at a large s64/u64 + // range is going to be imprecise anyway, with this check we at least make the edge values matches expected limits. + if (t < 1.0) + { + FLOATTYPE v_new_off_f = (SIGNEDTYPE)(v_max - v_min) * t; + result = (TYPE)((SIGNEDTYPE)v_min + (SIGNEDTYPE)(v_new_off_f + (FLOATTYPE)(v_min > v_max ? -0.5 : 0.5))); + } + else + { + result = v_max; + } + } + } + + return result; +} + +// FIXME: Move more of the code into SliderBehavior() +template +bool ImGui::SliderBehaviorT(const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id, ImGuiDataType data_type, TYPE* v, const TYPE v_min, const TYPE v_max, const char* format, ImGuiSliderFlags flags, ImRect* out_grab_bb) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style; + + const ImGuiAxis axis = (flags & ImGuiSliderFlags_Vertical) ? ImGuiAxis_Y : ImGuiAxis_X; + const bool is_logarithmic = (flags & ImGuiSliderFlags_Logarithmic) != 0; + const bool is_floating_point = (data_type == ImGuiDataType_Float) || (data_type == ImGuiDataType_Double); + + const float grab_padding = 2.0f; + const float slider_sz = (bb.Max[axis] - bb.Min[axis]) - grab_padding * 2.0f; + float grab_sz = style.GrabMinSize; + SIGNEDTYPE v_range = (v_min < v_max ? v_max - v_min : v_min - v_max); + if (!is_floating_point && v_range >= 0) // v_range < 0 may happen on integer overflows + grab_sz = ImMax((float)(slider_sz / (v_range + 1)), style.GrabMinSize); // For integer sliders: if possible have the grab size represent 1 unit + grab_sz = ImMin(grab_sz, slider_sz); + const float slider_usable_sz = slider_sz - grab_sz; + const float slider_usable_pos_min = bb.Min[axis] + grab_padding + grab_sz * 0.5f; + const float slider_usable_pos_max = bb.Max[axis] - grab_padding - grab_sz * 0.5f; + + float logarithmic_zero_epsilon = 0.0f; // Only valid when is_logarithmic is true + float zero_deadzone_halfsize = 0.0f; // Only valid when is_logarithmic is true + if (is_logarithmic) + { + // When using logarithmic sliders, we need to clamp to avoid hitting zero, but our choice of clamp value greatly affects slider precision. We attempt to use the specified precision to estimate a good lower bound. + const int decimal_precision = is_floating_point ? ImParseFormatPrecision(format, 3) : 1; + logarithmic_zero_epsilon = ImPow(0.1f, (float)decimal_precision); + zero_deadzone_halfsize = (style.LogSliderDeadzone * 0.5f) / ImMax(slider_usable_sz, 1.0f); + } + + // Process interacting with the slider + bool value_changed = false; + if (g.ActiveId == id) + { + bool set_new_value = false; + float clicked_t = 0.0f; + if (g.ActiveIdSource == ImGuiInputSource_Mouse) + { + if (!g.IO.MouseDown[0]) + { + ClearActiveID(); + } + else + { + const float mouse_abs_pos = g.IO.MousePos[axis]; + clicked_t = (slider_usable_sz > 0.0f) ? ImClamp((mouse_abs_pos - slider_usable_pos_min) / slider_usable_sz, 0.0f, 1.0f) : 0.0f; + if (axis == ImGuiAxis_Y) + clicked_t = 1.0f - clicked_t; + set_new_value = true; + } + } + else if (g.ActiveIdSource == ImGuiInputSource_Nav) + { + if (g.ActiveIdIsJustActivated) + { + g.SliderCurrentAccum = 0.0f; // Reset any stored nav delta upon activation + g.SliderCurrentAccumDirty = false; + } + + const ImVec2 input_delta2 = GetNavInputAmount2d(ImGuiNavDirSourceFlags_Keyboard | ImGuiNavDirSourceFlags_PadDPad, ImGuiInputReadMode_RepeatFast, 0.0f, 0.0f); + float input_delta = (axis == ImGuiAxis_X) ? input_delta2.x : -input_delta2.y; + if (input_delta != 0.0f) + { + const int decimal_precision = is_floating_point ? ImParseFormatPrecision(format, 3) : 0; + if (decimal_precision > 0) + { + input_delta /= 100.0f; // Gamepad/keyboard tweak speeds in % of slider bounds + if (IsNavInputDown(ImGuiNavInput_TweakSlow)) + input_delta /= 10.0f; + } + else + { + if ((v_range >= -100.0f && v_range <= 100.0f) || IsNavInputDown(ImGuiNavInput_TweakSlow)) + input_delta = ((input_delta < 0.0f) ? -1.0f : +1.0f) / (float)v_range; // Gamepad/keyboard tweak speeds in integer steps + else + input_delta /= 100.0f; + } + if (IsNavInputDown(ImGuiNavInput_TweakFast)) + input_delta *= 10.0f; + + g.SliderCurrentAccum += input_delta; + g.SliderCurrentAccumDirty = true; + } + + float delta = g.SliderCurrentAccum; + if (g.NavActivatePressedId == id && !g.ActiveIdIsJustActivated) + { + ClearActiveID(); + } + else if (g.SliderCurrentAccumDirty) + { + clicked_t = ScaleRatioFromValueT(data_type, *v, v_min, v_max, is_logarithmic, logarithmic_zero_epsilon, zero_deadzone_halfsize); + + if ((clicked_t >= 1.0f && delta > 0.0f) || (clicked_t <= 0.0f && delta < 0.0f)) // This is to avoid applying the saturation when already past the limits + { + set_new_value = false; + g.SliderCurrentAccum = 0.0f; // If pushing up against the limits, don't continue to accumulate + } + else + { + set_new_value = true; + float old_clicked_t = clicked_t; + clicked_t = ImSaturate(clicked_t + delta); + + // Calculate what our "new" clicked_t will be, and thus how far we actually moved the slider, and subtract this from the accumulator + TYPE v_new = ScaleValueFromRatioT(data_type, clicked_t, v_min, v_max, is_logarithmic, logarithmic_zero_epsilon, zero_deadzone_halfsize); + if (!(flags & ImGuiSliderFlags_NoRoundToFormat)) + v_new = RoundScalarWithFormatT(format, data_type, v_new); + float new_clicked_t = ScaleRatioFromValueT(data_type, v_new, v_min, v_max, is_logarithmic, logarithmic_zero_epsilon, zero_deadzone_halfsize); + + if (delta > 0) + g.SliderCurrentAccum -= ImMin(new_clicked_t - old_clicked_t, delta); + else + g.SliderCurrentAccum -= ImMax(new_clicked_t - old_clicked_t, delta); + } + + g.SliderCurrentAccumDirty = false; + } + } + + if (set_new_value) + { + TYPE v_new = ScaleValueFromRatioT(data_type, clicked_t, v_min, v_max, is_logarithmic, logarithmic_zero_epsilon, zero_deadzone_halfsize); + + // Round to user desired precision based on format string + if (!(flags & ImGuiSliderFlags_NoRoundToFormat)) + v_new = RoundScalarWithFormatT(format, data_type, v_new); + + // Apply result + if (*v != v_new) + { + *v = v_new; + value_changed = true; + } + } + } + + if (slider_sz < 1.0f) + { + *out_grab_bb = ImRect(bb.Min, bb.Min); + } + else + { + // Output grab position so it can be displayed by the caller + float grab_t = ScaleRatioFromValueT(data_type, *v, v_min, v_max, is_logarithmic, logarithmic_zero_epsilon, zero_deadzone_halfsize); + if (axis == ImGuiAxis_Y) + grab_t = 1.0f - grab_t; + const float grab_pos = ImLerp(slider_usable_pos_min, slider_usable_pos_max, grab_t); + if (axis == ImGuiAxis_X) + *out_grab_bb = ImRect(grab_pos - grab_sz * 0.5f, bb.Min.y + grab_padding, grab_pos + grab_sz * 0.5f, bb.Max.y - grab_padding); + else + *out_grab_bb = ImRect(bb.Min.x + grab_padding, grab_pos - grab_sz * 0.5f, bb.Max.x - grab_padding, grab_pos + grab_sz * 0.5f); + } + + return value_changed; +} + +// For 32-bit and larger types, slider bounds are limited to half the natural type range. +// So e.g. an integer Slider between INT_MAX-10 and INT_MAX will fail, but an integer Slider between INT_MAX/2-10 and INT_MAX/2 will be ok. +// It would be possible to lift that limitation with some work but it doesn't seem to be worth it for sliders. +bool ImGui::SliderBehavior(const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* p_v, const void* p_min, const void* p_max, const char* format, ImGuiSliderFlags flags, ImRect* out_grab_bb) +{ + // Read imgui.cpp "API BREAKING CHANGES" section for 1.78 if you hit this assert. + IM_ASSERT((flags == 1 || (flags & ImGuiSliderFlags_InvalidMask_) == 0) && "Invalid ImGuiSliderFlags flag! Has the 'float power' argument been mistakenly cast to flags? Call function with ImGuiSliderFlags_Logarithmic flags instead."); + + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + if ((g.LastItemData.InFlags & ImGuiItemFlags_ReadOnly) || (flags & ImGuiSliderFlags_ReadOnly)) + return false; + + switch (data_type) + { + case ImGuiDataType_S8: { ImS32 v32 = (ImS32)*(ImS8*)p_v; bool r = SliderBehaviorT(bb, id, ImGuiDataType_S32, &v32, *(const ImS8*)p_min, *(const ImS8*)p_max, format, flags, out_grab_bb); if (r) *(ImS8*)p_v = (ImS8)v32; return r; } + case ImGuiDataType_U8: { ImU32 v32 = (ImU32)*(ImU8*)p_v; bool r = SliderBehaviorT(bb, id, ImGuiDataType_U32, &v32, *(const ImU8*)p_min, *(const ImU8*)p_max, format, flags, out_grab_bb); if (r) *(ImU8*)p_v = (ImU8)v32; return r; } + case ImGuiDataType_S16: { ImS32 v32 = (ImS32)*(ImS16*)p_v; bool r = SliderBehaviorT(bb, id, ImGuiDataType_S32, &v32, *(const ImS16*)p_min, *(const ImS16*)p_max, format, flags, out_grab_bb); if (r) *(ImS16*)p_v = (ImS16)v32; return r; } + case ImGuiDataType_U16: { ImU32 v32 = (ImU32)*(ImU16*)p_v; bool r = SliderBehaviorT(bb, id, ImGuiDataType_U32, &v32, *(const ImU16*)p_min, *(const ImU16*)p_max, format, flags, out_grab_bb); if (r) *(ImU16*)p_v = (ImU16)v32; return r; } + case ImGuiDataType_S32: + IM_ASSERT(*(const ImS32*)p_min >= IM_S32_MIN / 2 && *(const ImS32*)p_max <= IM_S32_MAX / 2); + return SliderBehaviorT(bb, id, data_type, (ImS32*)p_v, *(const ImS32*)p_min, *(const ImS32*)p_max, format, flags, out_grab_bb); + case ImGuiDataType_U32: + IM_ASSERT(*(const ImU32*)p_max <= IM_U32_MAX / 2); + return SliderBehaviorT(bb, id, data_type, (ImU32*)p_v, *(const ImU32*)p_min, *(const ImU32*)p_max, format, flags, out_grab_bb); + case ImGuiDataType_S64: + IM_ASSERT(*(const ImS64*)p_min >= IM_S64_MIN / 2 && *(const ImS64*)p_max <= IM_S64_MAX / 2); + return SliderBehaviorT(bb, id, data_type, (ImS64*)p_v, *(const ImS64*)p_min, *(const ImS64*)p_max, format, flags, out_grab_bb); + case ImGuiDataType_U64: + IM_ASSERT(*(const ImU64*)p_max <= IM_U64_MAX / 2); + return SliderBehaviorT(bb, id, data_type, (ImU64*)p_v, *(const ImU64*)p_min, *(const ImU64*)p_max, format, flags, out_grab_bb); + case ImGuiDataType_Float: + IM_ASSERT(*(const float*)p_min >= -FLT_MAX / 2.0f && *(const float*)p_max <= FLT_MAX / 2.0f); + return SliderBehaviorT(bb, id, data_type, (float*)p_v, *(const float*)p_min, *(const float*)p_max, format, flags, out_grab_bb); + case ImGuiDataType_Double: + IM_ASSERT(*(const double*)p_min >= -DBL_MAX / 2.0f && *(const double*)p_max <= DBL_MAX / 2.0f); + return SliderBehaviorT(bb, id, data_type, (double*)p_v, *(const double*)p_min, *(const double*)p_max, format, flags, out_grab_bb); + case ImGuiDataType_COUNT: break; + } + IM_ASSERT(0); + return false; +} + +// Note: p_data, p_min and p_max are _pointers_ to a memory address holding the data. For a slider, they are all required. +// Read code of e.g. SliderFloat(), SliderInt() etc. or examples in 'Demo->Widgets->Data Types' to understand how to use this function directly. +bool ImGui::SliderScalar(const char* label, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* p_data, const void* p_min, const void* p_max, const char* format, ImGuiSliderFlags flags) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + if (window->SkipItems) + return false; + + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style; + const ImGuiID id = window->GetID(label); + const float w = CalcItemWidth(); + + const ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true); + const ImRect frame_bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + ImVec2(w, label_size.y + style.FramePadding.y * 2.0f)); + const ImRect total_bb(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max + ImVec2(label_size.x > 0.0f ? style.ItemInnerSpacing.x + label_size.x : 0.0f, 0.0f)); + + const bool temp_input_allowed = (flags & ImGuiSliderFlags_NoInput) == 0; + ItemSize(total_bb, style.FramePadding.y); + if (!ItemAdd(total_bb, id, &frame_bb, temp_input_allowed ? ImGuiItemAddFlags_Focusable : 0)) + return false; + + // Default format string when passing NULL + if (format == NULL) + format = DataTypeGetInfo(data_type)->PrintFmt; + else if (data_type == ImGuiDataType_S32 && strcmp(format, "%d") != 0) // (FIXME-LEGACY: Patch old "%.0f" format string to use "%d", read function more details.) + format = PatchFormatStringFloatToInt(format); + + // Tabbing or CTRL-clicking on Slider turns it into an input box + const bool hovered = ItemHoverable(frame_bb, id); + bool temp_input_is_active = temp_input_allowed && TempInputIsActive(id); + if (!temp_input_is_active) + { + const bool focus_requested = temp_input_allowed && (g.LastItemData.StatusFlags & ImGuiItemStatusFlags_Focused) != 0; + const bool clicked = (hovered && g.IO.MouseClicked[0]); + if (focus_requested || clicked || g.NavActivateId == id || g.NavInputId == id) + { + SetActiveID(id, window); + SetFocusID(id, window); + FocusWindow(window); + g.ActiveIdUsingNavDirMask |= (1 << ImGuiDir_Left) | (1 << ImGuiDir_Right); + if (temp_input_allowed && (focus_requested || (clicked && g.IO.KeyCtrl) || g.NavInputId == id)) + temp_input_is_active = true; + } + } + + if (temp_input_is_active) + { + // Only clamp CTRL+Click input when ImGuiSliderFlags_AlwaysClamp is set + const bool is_clamp_input = (flags & ImGuiSliderFlags_AlwaysClamp) != 0; + return TempInputScalar(frame_bb, id, label, data_type, p_data, format, is_clamp_input ? p_min : NULL, is_clamp_input ? p_max : NULL); + } + + // Draw frame + const ImU32 frame_col = GetColorU32(g.ActiveId == id ? ImGuiCol_FrameBgActive : hovered ? ImGuiCol_FrameBgHovered : ImGuiCol_FrameBg); + RenderNavHighlight(frame_bb, id); + RenderFrame(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max, frame_col, true, g.Style.FrameRounding); + + // Slider behavior + ImRect grab_bb; + const bool value_changed = SliderBehavior(frame_bb, id, data_type, p_data, p_min, p_max, format, flags, &grab_bb); + if (value_changed) + MarkItemEdited(id); + + // Render grab + if (grab_bb.Max.x > grab_bb.Min.x) + window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(grab_bb.Min, grab_bb.Max, GetColorU32(g.ActiveId == id ? ImGuiCol_SliderGrabActive : ImGuiCol_SliderGrab), style.GrabRounding); + + // Display value using user-provided display format so user can add prefix/suffix/decorations to the value. + char value_buf[64]; + const char* value_buf_end = value_buf + DataTypeFormatString(value_buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(value_buf), data_type, p_data, format); + if (g.LogEnabled) + LogSetNextTextDecoration("{", "}"); + RenderTextClipped(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max, value_buf, value_buf_end, NULL, ImVec2(0.5f, 0.5f)); + + if (label_size.x > 0.0f) + RenderText(ImVec2(frame_bb.Max.x + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x, frame_bb.Min.y + style.FramePadding.y), label); + + IMGUI_TEST_ENGINE_ITEM_INFO(id, label, g.LastItemData.StatusFlags); + return value_changed; +} + +// Add multiple sliders on 1 line for compact edition of multiple components +bool ImGui::SliderScalarN(const char* label, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* v, int components, const void* v_min, const void* v_max, const char* format, ImGuiSliderFlags flags) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + if (window->SkipItems) + return false; + + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + bool value_changed = false; + BeginGroup(); + PushID(label); + PushMultiItemsWidths(components, CalcItemWidth()); + size_t type_size = GDataTypeInfo[data_type].Size; + for (int i = 0; i < components; i++) + { + PushID(i); + if (i > 0) + SameLine(0, g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x); + value_changed |= SliderScalar("", data_type, v, v_min, v_max, format, flags); + PopID(); + PopItemWidth(); + v = (void*)((char*)v + type_size); + } + PopID(); + + const char* label_end = FindRenderedTextEnd(label); + if (label != label_end) + { + SameLine(0, g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x); + TextEx(label, label_end); + } + + EndGroup(); + return value_changed; +} + +bool ImGui::SliderFloat(const char* label, float* v, float v_min, float v_max, const char* format, ImGuiSliderFlags flags) +{ + return SliderScalar(label, ImGuiDataType_Float, v, &v_min, &v_max, format, flags); +} + +bool ImGui::SliderFloat2(const char* label, float v[2], float v_min, float v_max, const char* format, ImGuiSliderFlags flags) +{ + return SliderScalarN(label, ImGuiDataType_Float, v, 2, &v_min, &v_max, format, flags); +} + +bool ImGui::SliderFloat3(const char* label, float v[3], float v_min, float v_max, const char* format, ImGuiSliderFlags flags) +{ + return SliderScalarN(label, ImGuiDataType_Float, v, 3, &v_min, &v_max, format, flags); +} + +bool ImGui::SliderFloat4(const char* label, float v[4], float v_min, float v_max, const char* format, ImGuiSliderFlags flags) +{ + return SliderScalarN(label, ImGuiDataType_Float, v, 4, &v_min, &v_max, format, flags); +} + +bool ImGui::SliderAngle(const char* label, float* v_rad, float v_degrees_min, float v_degrees_max, const char* format, ImGuiSliderFlags flags) +{ + if (format == NULL) + format = "%.0f deg"; + float v_deg = (*v_rad) * 360.0f / (2 * IM_PI); + bool value_changed = SliderFloat(label, &v_deg, v_degrees_min, v_degrees_max, format, flags); + *v_rad = v_deg * (2 * IM_PI) / 360.0f; + return value_changed; +} + +bool ImGui::SliderInt(const char* label, int* v, int v_min, int v_max, const char* format, ImGuiSliderFlags flags) +{ + return SliderScalar(label, ImGuiDataType_S32, v, &v_min, &v_max, format, flags); +} + +bool ImGui::SliderInt2(const char* label, int v[2], int v_min, int v_max, const char* format, ImGuiSliderFlags flags) +{ + return SliderScalarN(label, ImGuiDataType_S32, v, 2, &v_min, &v_max, format, flags); +} + +bool ImGui::SliderInt3(const char* label, int v[3], int v_min, int v_max, const char* format, ImGuiSliderFlags flags) +{ + return SliderScalarN(label, ImGuiDataType_S32, v, 3, &v_min, &v_max, format, flags); +} + +bool ImGui::SliderInt4(const char* label, int v[4], int v_min, int v_max, const char* format, ImGuiSliderFlags flags) +{ + return SliderScalarN(label, ImGuiDataType_S32, v, 4, &v_min, &v_max, format, flags); +} + +bool ImGui::VSliderScalar(const char* label, const ImVec2& size, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* p_data, const void* p_min, const void* p_max, const char* format, ImGuiSliderFlags flags) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + if (window->SkipItems) + return false; + + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style; + const ImGuiID id = window->GetID(label); + + const ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true); + const ImRect frame_bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + size); + const ImRect bb(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max + ImVec2(label_size.x > 0.0f ? style.ItemInnerSpacing.x + label_size.x : 0.0f, 0.0f)); + + ItemSize(bb, style.FramePadding.y); + if (!ItemAdd(frame_bb, id)) + return false; + + // Default format string when passing NULL + if (format == NULL) + format = DataTypeGetInfo(data_type)->PrintFmt; + else if (data_type == ImGuiDataType_S32 && strcmp(format, "%d") != 0) // (FIXME-LEGACY: Patch old "%.0f" format string to use "%d", read function more details.) + format = PatchFormatStringFloatToInt(format); + + const bool hovered = ItemHoverable(frame_bb, id); + if ((hovered && g.IO.MouseClicked[0]) || g.NavActivateId == id || g.NavInputId == id) + { + SetActiveID(id, window); + SetFocusID(id, window); + FocusWindow(window); + g.ActiveIdUsingNavDirMask |= (1 << ImGuiDir_Up) | (1 << ImGuiDir_Down); + } + + // Draw frame + const ImU32 frame_col = GetColorU32(g.ActiveId == id ? ImGuiCol_FrameBgActive : hovered ? ImGuiCol_FrameBgHovered : ImGuiCol_FrameBg); + RenderNavHighlight(frame_bb, id); + RenderFrame(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max, frame_col, true, g.Style.FrameRounding); + + // Slider behavior + ImRect grab_bb; + const bool value_changed = SliderBehavior(frame_bb, id, data_type, p_data, p_min, p_max, format, flags | ImGuiSliderFlags_Vertical, &grab_bb); + if (value_changed) + MarkItemEdited(id); + + // Render grab + if (grab_bb.Max.y > grab_bb.Min.y) + window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(grab_bb.Min, grab_bb.Max, GetColorU32(g.ActiveId == id ? ImGuiCol_SliderGrabActive : ImGuiCol_SliderGrab), style.GrabRounding); + + // Display value using user-provided display format so user can add prefix/suffix/decorations to the value. + // For the vertical slider we allow centered text to overlap the frame padding + char value_buf[64]; + const char* value_buf_end = value_buf + DataTypeFormatString(value_buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(value_buf), data_type, p_data, format); + RenderTextClipped(ImVec2(frame_bb.Min.x, frame_bb.Min.y + style.FramePadding.y), frame_bb.Max, value_buf, value_buf_end, NULL, ImVec2(0.5f, 0.0f)); + if (label_size.x > 0.0f) + RenderText(ImVec2(frame_bb.Max.x + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x, frame_bb.Min.y + style.FramePadding.y), label); + + return value_changed; +} + +bool ImGui::VSliderFloat(const char* label, const ImVec2& size, float* v, float v_min, float v_max, const char* format, ImGuiSliderFlags flags) +{ + return VSliderScalar(label, size, ImGuiDataType_Float, v, &v_min, &v_max, format, flags); +} + +bool ImGui::VSliderInt(const char* label, const ImVec2& size, int* v, int v_min, int v_max, const char* format, ImGuiSliderFlags flags) +{ + return VSliderScalar(label, size, ImGuiDataType_S32, v, &v_min, &v_max, format, flags); +} + +#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_OBSOLETE_FUNCTIONS + +// Obsolete versions with power parameter. See https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/issues/3361 for details. +bool ImGui::SliderScalar(const char* label, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* p_data, const void* p_min, const void* p_max, const char* format, float power) +{ + ImGuiSliderFlags slider_flags = ImGuiSliderFlags_None; + if (power != 1.0f) + { + IM_ASSERT(power == 1.0f && "Call function with ImGuiSliderFlags_Logarithmic flags instead of using the old 'float power' function!"); + slider_flags |= ImGuiSliderFlags_Logarithmic; // Fallback for non-asserting paths + } + return SliderScalar(label, data_type, p_data, p_min, p_max, format, slider_flags); +} + +bool ImGui::SliderScalarN(const char* label, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* v, int components, const void* v_min, const void* v_max, const char* format, float power) +{ + ImGuiSliderFlags slider_flags = ImGuiSliderFlags_None; + if (power != 1.0f) + { + IM_ASSERT(power == 1.0f && "Call function with ImGuiSliderFlags_Logarithmic flags instead of using the old 'float power' function!"); + slider_flags |= ImGuiSliderFlags_Logarithmic; // Fallback for non-asserting paths + } + return SliderScalarN(label, data_type, v, components, v_min, v_max, format, slider_flags); +} + +#endif // IMGUI_DISABLE_OBSOLETE_FUNCTIONS + +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Widgets: InputScalar, InputFloat, InputInt, etc. +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// - ImParseFormatFindStart() [Internal] +// - ImParseFormatFindEnd() [Internal] +// - ImParseFormatTrimDecorations() [Internal] +// - ImParseFormatPrecision() [Internal] +// - TempInputTextScalar() [Internal] +// - InputScalar() +// - InputScalarN() +// - InputFloat() +// - InputFloat2() +// - InputFloat3() +// - InputFloat4() +// - InputInt() +// - InputInt2() +// - InputInt3() +// - InputInt4() +// - InputDouble() +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// We don't use strchr() because our strings are usually very short and often start with '%' +const char* ImParseFormatFindStart(const char* fmt) +{ + while (char c = fmt[0]) + { + if (c == '%' && fmt[1] != '%') + return fmt; + else if (c == '%') + fmt++; + fmt++; + } + return fmt; +} + +const char* ImParseFormatFindEnd(const char* fmt) +{ + // Printf/scanf types modifiers: I/L/h/j/l/t/w/z. Other uppercase letters qualify as types aka end of the format. + if (fmt[0] != '%') + return fmt; + const unsigned int ignored_uppercase_mask = (1 << ('I'-'A')) | (1 << ('L'-'A')); + const unsigned int ignored_lowercase_mask = (1 << ('h'-'a')) | (1 << ('j'-'a')) | (1 << ('l'-'a')) | (1 << ('t'-'a')) | (1 << ('w'-'a')) | (1 << ('z'-'a')); + for (char c; (c = *fmt) != 0; fmt++) + { + if (c >= 'A' && c <= 'Z' && ((1 << (c - 'A')) & ignored_uppercase_mask) == 0) + return fmt + 1; + if (c >= 'a' && c <= 'z' && ((1 << (c - 'a')) & ignored_lowercase_mask) == 0) + return fmt + 1; + } + return fmt; +} + +// Extract the format out of a format string with leading or trailing decorations +// fmt = "blah blah" -> return fmt +// fmt = "%.3f" -> return fmt +// fmt = "hello %.3f" -> return fmt + 6 +// fmt = "%.3f hello" -> return buf written with "%.3f" +const char* ImParseFormatTrimDecorations(const char* fmt, char* buf, size_t buf_size) +{ + const char* fmt_start = ImParseFormatFindStart(fmt); + if (fmt_start[0] != '%') + return fmt; + const char* fmt_end = ImParseFormatFindEnd(fmt_start); + if (fmt_end[0] == 0) // If we only have leading decoration, we don't need to copy the data. + return fmt_start; + ImStrncpy(buf, fmt_start, ImMin((size_t)(fmt_end - fmt_start) + 1, buf_size)); + return buf; +} + +// Parse display precision back from the display format string +// FIXME: This is still used by some navigation code path to infer a minimum tweak step, but we should aim to rework widgets so it isn't needed. +int ImParseFormatPrecision(const char* fmt, int default_precision) +{ + fmt = ImParseFormatFindStart(fmt); + if (fmt[0] != '%') + return default_precision; + fmt++; + while (*fmt >= '0' && *fmt <= '9') + fmt++; + int precision = INT_MAX; + if (*fmt == '.') + { + fmt = ImAtoi(fmt + 1, &precision); + if (precision < 0 || precision > 99) + precision = default_precision; + } + if (*fmt == 'e' || *fmt == 'E') // Maximum precision with scientific notation + precision = -1; + if ((*fmt == 'g' || *fmt == 'G') && precision == INT_MAX) + precision = -1; + return (precision == INT_MAX) ? default_precision : precision; +} + +// Create text input in place of another active widget (e.g. used when doing a CTRL+Click on drag/slider widgets) +// FIXME: Facilitate using this in variety of other situations. +bool ImGui::TempInputText(const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id, const char* label, char* buf, int buf_size, ImGuiInputTextFlags flags) +{ + // On the first frame, g.TempInputTextId == 0, then on subsequent frames it becomes == id. + // We clear ActiveID on the first frame to allow the InputText() taking it back. + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + const bool init = (g.TempInputId != id); + if (init) + ClearActiveID(); + + g.CurrentWindow->DC.CursorPos = bb.Min; + bool value_changed = InputTextEx(label, NULL, buf, buf_size, bb.GetSize(), flags | ImGuiInputTextFlags_MergedItem); + if (init) + { + // First frame we started displaying the InputText widget, we expect it to take the active id. + IM_ASSERT(g.ActiveId == id); + g.TempInputId = g.ActiveId; + } + return value_changed; +} + +// Note that Drag/Slider functions are only forwarding the min/max values clamping values if the ImGuiSliderFlags_AlwaysClamp flag is set! +// This is intended: this way we allow CTRL+Click manual input to set a value out of bounds, for maximum flexibility. +// However this may not be ideal for all uses, as some user code may break on out of bound values. +bool ImGui::TempInputScalar(const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id, const char* label, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* p_data, const char* format, const void* p_clamp_min, const void* p_clamp_max) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + + char fmt_buf[32]; + char data_buf[32]; + format = ImParseFormatTrimDecorations(format, fmt_buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(fmt_buf)); + DataTypeFormatString(data_buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(data_buf), data_type, p_data, format); + ImStrTrimBlanks(data_buf); + + ImGuiInputTextFlags flags = ImGuiInputTextFlags_AutoSelectAll | ImGuiInputTextFlags_NoMarkEdited; + flags |= ((data_type == ImGuiDataType_Float || data_type == ImGuiDataType_Double) ? ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsScientific : ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsDecimal); + bool value_changed = false; + if (TempInputText(bb, id, label, data_buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(data_buf), flags)) + { + // Backup old value + size_t data_type_size = DataTypeGetInfo(data_type)->Size; + ImGuiDataTypeTempStorage data_backup; + memcpy(&data_backup, p_data, data_type_size); + + // Apply new value (or operations) then clamp + DataTypeApplyOpFromText(data_buf, g.InputTextState.InitialTextA.Data, data_type, p_data, NULL); + if (p_clamp_min || p_clamp_max) + { + if (p_clamp_min && p_clamp_max && DataTypeCompare(data_type, p_clamp_min, p_clamp_max) > 0) + ImSwap(p_clamp_min, p_clamp_max); + DataTypeClamp(data_type, p_data, p_clamp_min, p_clamp_max); + } + + // Only mark as edited if new value is different + value_changed = memcmp(&data_backup, p_data, data_type_size) != 0; + if (value_changed) + MarkItemEdited(id); + } + return value_changed; +} + +// Note: p_data, p_step, p_step_fast are _pointers_ to a memory address holding the data. For an Input widget, p_step and p_step_fast are optional. +// Read code of e.g. InputFloat(), InputInt() etc. or examples in 'Demo->Widgets->Data Types' to understand how to use this function directly. +bool ImGui::InputScalar(const char* label, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* p_data, const void* p_step, const void* p_step_fast, const char* format, ImGuiInputTextFlags flags) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + if (window->SkipItems) + return false; + + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style; + + if (format == NULL) + format = DataTypeGetInfo(data_type)->PrintFmt; + + char buf[64]; + DataTypeFormatString(buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf), data_type, p_data, format); + + bool value_changed = false; + if ((flags & (ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsHexadecimal | ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsScientific)) == 0) + flags |= ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsDecimal; + flags |= ImGuiInputTextFlags_AutoSelectAll; + flags |= ImGuiInputTextFlags_NoMarkEdited; // We call MarkItemEdited() ourselves by comparing the actual data rather than the string. + + if (p_step != NULL) + { + const float button_size = GetFrameHeight(); + + BeginGroup(); // The only purpose of the group here is to allow the caller to query item data e.g. IsItemActive() + PushID(label); + SetNextItemWidth(ImMax(1.0f, CalcItemWidth() - (button_size + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x) * 2)); + if (InputText("", buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf), flags)) // PushId(label) + "" gives us the expected ID from outside point of view + value_changed = DataTypeApplyOpFromText(buf, g.InputTextState.InitialTextA.Data, data_type, p_data, format); + + // Step buttons + const ImVec2 backup_frame_padding = style.FramePadding; + style.FramePadding.x = style.FramePadding.y; + ImGuiButtonFlags button_flags = ImGuiButtonFlags_Repeat | ImGuiButtonFlags_DontClosePopups; + if (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_ReadOnly) + BeginDisabled(true); + SameLine(0, style.ItemInnerSpacing.x); + if (ButtonEx("-", ImVec2(button_size, button_size), button_flags)) + { + DataTypeApplyOp(data_type, '-', p_data, p_data, g.IO.KeyCtrl && p_step_fast ? p_step_fast : p_step); + value_changed = true; + } + SameLine(0, style.ItemInnerSpacing.x); + if (ButtonEx("+", ImVec2(button_size, button_size), button_flags)) + { + DataTypeApplyOp(data_type, '+', p_data, p_data, g.IO.KeyCtrl && p_step_fast ? p_step_fast : p_step); + value_changed = true; + } + if (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_ReadOnly) + EndDisabled(); + + const char* label_end = FindRenderedTextEnd(label); + if (label != label_end) + { + SameLine(0, style.ItemInnerSpacing.x); + TextEx(label, label_end); + } + style.FramePadding = backup_frame_padding; + + PopID(); + EndGroup(); + } + else + { + if (InputText(label, buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf), flags)) + value_changed = DataTypeApplyOpFromText(buf, g.InputTextState.InitialTextA.Data, data_type, p_data, format); + } + if (value_changed) + MarkItemEdited(g.LastItemData.ID); + + return value_changed; +} + +bool ImGui::InputScalarN(const char* label, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* p_data, int components, const void* p_step, const void* p_step_fast, const char* format, ImGuiInputTextFlags flags) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + if (window->SkipItems) + return false; + + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + bool value_changed = false; + BeginGroup(); + PushID(label); + PushMultiItemsWidths(components, CalcItemWidth()); + size_t type_size = GDataTypeInfo[data_type].Size; + for (int i = 0; i < components; i++) + { + PushID(i); + if (i > 0) + SameLine(0, g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x); + value_changed |= InputScalar("", data_type, p_data, p_step, p_step_fast, format, flags); + PopID(); + PopItemWidth(); + p_data = (void*)((char*)p_data + type_size); + } + PopID(); + + const char* label_end = FindRenderedTextEnd(label); + if (label != label_end) + { + SameLine(0.0f, g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x); + TextEx(label, label_end); + } + + EndGroup(); + return value_changed; +} + +bool ImGui::InputFloat(const char* label, float* v, float step, float step_fast, const char* format, ImGuiInputTextFlags flags) +{ + flags |= ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsScientific; + return InputScalar(label, ImGuiDataType_Float, (void*)v, (void*)(step > 0.0f ? &step : NULL), (void*)(step_fast > 0.0f ? &step_fast : NULL), format, flags); +} + +bool ImGui::InputFloat2(const char* label, float v[2], const char* format, ImGuiInputTextFlags flags) +{ + return InputScalarN(label, ImGuiDataType_Float, v, 2, NULL, NULL, format, flags); +} + +bool ImGui::InputFloat3(const char* label, float v[3], const char* format, ImGuiInputTextFlags flags) +{ + return InputScalarN(label, ImGuiDataType_Float, v, 3, NULL, NULL, format, flags); +} + +bool ImGui::InputFloat4(const char* label, float v[4], const char* format, ImGuiInputTextFlags flags) +{ + return InputScalarN(label, ImGuiDataType_Float, v, 4, NULL, NULL, format, flags); +} + +bool ImGui::InputInt(const char* label, int* v, int step, int step_fast, ImGuiInputTextFlags flags) +{ + // Hexadecimal input provided as a convenience but the flag name is awkward. Typically you'd use InputText() to parse your own data, if you want to handle prefixes. + const char* format = (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsHexadecimal) ? "%08X" : "%d"; + return InputScalar(label, ImGuiDataType_S32, (void*)v, (void*)(step > 0 ? &step : NULL), (void*)(step_fast > 0 ? &step_fast : NULL), format, flags); +} + +bool ImGui::InputInt2(const char* label, int v[2], ImGuiInputTextFlags flags) +{ + return InputScalarN(label, ImGuiDataType_S32, v, 2, NULL, NULL, "%d", flags); +} + +bool ImGui::InputInt3(const char* label, int v[3], ImGuiInputTextFlags flags) +{ + return InputScalarN(label, ImGuiDataType_S32, v, 3, NULL, NULL, "%d", flags); +} + +bool ImGui::InputInt4(const char* label, int v[4], ImGuiInputTextFlags flags) +{ + return InputScalarN(label, ImGuiDataType_S32, v, 4, NULL, NULL, "%d", flags); +} + +bool ImGui::InputDouble(const char* label, double* v, double step, double step_fast, const char* format, ImGuiInputTextFlags flags) +{ + flags |= ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsScientific; + return InputScalar(label, ImGuiDataType_Double, (void*)v, (void*)(step > 0.0 ? &step : NULL), (void*)(step_fast > 0.0 ? &step_fast : NULL), format, flags); +} + +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Widgets: InputText, InputTextMultiline, InputTextWithHint +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// - InputText() +// - InputTextWithHint() +// - InputTextMultiline() +// - InputTextEx() [Internal] +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +bool ImGui::InputText(const char* label, char* buf, size_t buf_size, ImGuiInputTextFlags flags, ImGuiInputTextCallback callback, void* user_data) +{ + IM_ASSERT(!(flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_Multiline)); // call InputTextMultiline() + return InputTextEx(label, NULL, buf, (int)buf_size, ImVec2(0, 0), flags, callback, user_data); +} + +bool ImGui::InputTextMultiline(const char* label, char* buf, size_t buf_size, const ImVec2& size, ImGuiInputTextFlags flags, ImGuiInputTextCallback callback, void* user_data) +{ + return InputTextEx(label, NULL, buf, (int)buf_size, size, flags | ImGuiInputTextFlags_Multiline, callback, user_data); +} + +bool ImGui::InputTextWithHint(const char* label, const char* hint, char* buf, size_t buf_size, ImGuiInputTextFlags flags, ImGuiInputTextCallback callback, void* user_data) +{ + IM_ASSERT(!(flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_Multiline)); // call InputTextMultiline() + return InputTextEx(label, hint, buf, (int)buf_size, ImVec2(0, 0), flags, callback, user_data); +} + +static int InputTextCalcTextLenAndLineCount(const char* text_begin, const char** out_text_end) +{ + int line_count = 0; + const char* s = text_begin; + while (char c = *s++) // We are only matching for \n so we can ignore UTF-8 decoding + if (c == '\n') + line_count++; + s--; + if (s[0] != '\n' && s[0] != '\r') + line_count++; + *out_text_end = s; + return line_count; +} + +static ImVec2 InputTextCalcTextSizeW(const ImWchar* text_begin, const ImWchar* text_end, const ImWchar** remaining, ImVec2* out_offset, bool stop_on_new_line) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImFont* font = g.Font; + const float line_height = g.FontSize; + const float scale = line_height / font->FontSize; + + ImVec2 text_size = ImVec2(0, 0); + float line_width = 0.0f; + + const ImWchar* s = text_begin; + while (s < text_end) + { + unsigned int c = (unsigned int)(*s++); + if (c == '\n') + { + text_size.x = ImMax(text_size.x, line_width); + text_size.y += line_height; + line_width = 0.0f; + if (stop_on_new_line) + break; + continue; + } + if (c == '\r') + continue; + + const float char_width = font->GetCharAdvance((ImWchar)c) * scale; + line_width += char_width; + } + + if (text_size.x < line_width) + text_size.x = line_width; + + if (out_offset) + *out_offset = ImVec2(line_width, text_size.y + line_height); // offset allow for the possibility of sitting after a trailing \n + + if (line_width > 0 || text_size.y == 0.0f) // whereas size.y will ignore the trailing \n + text_size.y += line_height; + + if (remaining) + *remaining = s; + + return text_size; +} + +// Wrapper for stb_textedit.h to edit text (our wrapper is for: statically sized buffer, single-line, wchar characters. InputText converts between UTF-8 and wchar) +namespace ImStb +{ + +static int STB_TEXTEDIT_STRINGLEN(const ImGuiInputTextState* obj) { return obj->CurLenW; } +static ImWchar STB_TEXTEDIT_GETCHAR(const ImGuiInputTextState* obj, int idx) { return obj->TextW[idx]; } +static float STB_TEXTEDIT_GETWIDTH(ImGuiInputTextState* obj, int line_start_idx, int char_idx) { ImWchar c = obj->TextW[line_start_idx + char_idx]; if (c == '\n') return STB_TEXTEDIT_GETWIDTH_NEWLINE; ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; return g.Font->GetCharAdvance(c) * (g.FontSize / g.Font->FontSize); } +static int STB_TEXTEDIT_KEYTOTEXT(int key) { return key >= 0x200000 ? 0 : key; } +static ImWchar STB_TEXTEDIT_NEWLINE = '\n'; +static void STB_TEXTEDIT_LAYOUTROW(StbTexteditRow* r, ImGuiInputTextState* obj, int line_start_idx) +{ + const ImWchar* text = obj->TextW.Data; + const ImWchar* text_remaining = NULL; + const ImVec2 size = InputTextCalcTextSizeW(text + line_start_idx, text + obj->CurLenW, &text_remaining, NULL, true); + r->x0 = 0.0f; + r->x1 = size.x; + r->baseline_y_delta = size.y; + r->ymin = 0.0f; + r->ymax = size.y; + r->num_chars = (int)(text_remaining - (text + line_start_idx)); +} + +// When ImGuiInputTextFlags_Password is set, we don't want actions such as CTRL+Arrow to leak the fact that underlying data are blanks or separators. +static bool is_separator(unsigned int c) { return ImCharIsBlankW(c) || c==',' || c==';' || c=='(' || c==')' || c=='{' || c=='}' || c=='[' || c==']' || c=='|'; } +static int is_word_boundary_from_right(ImGuiInputTextState* obj, int idx) { if (obj->Flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_Password) return 0; return idx > 0 ? (is_separator(obj->TextW[idx - 1]) && !is_separator(obj->TextW[idx]) ) : 1; } +static int STB_TEXTEDIT_MOVEWORDLEFT_IMPL(ImGuiInputTextState* obj, int idx) { idx--; while (idx >= 0 && !is_word_boundary_from_right(obj, idx)) idx--; return idx < 0 ? 0 : idx; } +#ifdef __APPLE__ // FIXME: Move setting to IO structure +static int is_word_boundary_from_left(ImGuiInputTextState* obj, int idx) { if (obj->Flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_Password) return 0; return idx > 0 ? (!is_separator(obj->TextW[idx - 1]) && is_separator(obj->TextW[idx]) ) : 1; } +static int STB_TEXTEDIT_MOVEWORDRIGHT_IMPL(ImGuiInputTextState* obj, int idx) { idx++; int len = obj->CurLenW; while (idx < len && !is_word_boundary_from_left(obj, idx)) idx++; return idx > len ? len : idx; } +#else +static int STB_TEXTEDIT_MOVEWORDRIGHT_IMPL(ImGuiInputTextState* obj, int idx) { idx++; int len = obj->CurLenW; while (idx < len && !is_word_boundary_from_right(obj, idx)) idx++; return idx > len ? len : idx; } +#endif +#define STB_TEXTEDIT_MOVEWORDLEFT STB_TEXTEDIT_MOVEWORDLEFT_IMPL // They need to be #define for stb_textedit.h +#define STB_TEXTEDIT_MOVEWORDRIGHT STB_TEXTEDIT_MOVEWORDRIGHT_IMPL + +static void STB_TEXTEDIT_DELETECHARS(ImGuiInputTextState* obj, int pos, int n) +{ + ImWchar* dst = obj->TextW.Data + pos; + + // We maintain our buffer length in both UTF-8 and wchar formats + obj->Edited = true; + obj->CurLenA -= ImTextCountUtf8BytesFromStr(dst, dst + n); + obj->CurLenW -= n; + + // Offset remaining text (FIXME-OPT: Use memmove) + const ImWchar* src = obj->TextW.Data + pos + n; + while (ImWchar c = *src++) + *dst++ = c; + *dst = '\0'; +} + +static bool STB_TEXTEDIT_INSERTCHARS(ImGuiInputTextState* obj, int pos, const ImWchar* new_text, int new_text_len) +{ + const bool is_resizable = (obj->Flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackResize) != 0; + const int text_len = obj->CurLenW; + IM_ASSERT(pos <= text_len); + + const int new_text_len_utf8 = ImTextCountUtf8BytesFromStr(new_text, new_text + new_text_len); + if (!is_resizable && (new_text_len_utf8 + obj->CurLenA + 1 > obj->BufCapacityA)) + return false; + + // Grow internal buffer if needed + if (new_text_len + text_len + 1 > obj->TextW.Size) + { + if (!is_resizable) + return false; + IM_ASSERT(text_len < obj->TextW.Size); + obj->TextW.resize(text_len + ImClamp(new_text_len * 4, 32, ImMax(256, new_text_len)) + 1); + } + + ImWchar* text = obj->TextW.Data; + if (pos != text_len) + memmove(text + pos + new_text_len, text + pos, (size_t)(text_len - pos) * sizeof(ImWchar)); + memcpy(text + pos, new_text, (size_t)new_text_len * sizeof(ImWchar)); + + obj->Edited = true; + obj->CurLenW += new_text_len; + obj->CurLenA += new_text_len_utf8; + obj->TextW[obj->CurLenW] = '\0'; + + return true; +} + +// We don't use an enum so we can build even with conflicting symbols (if another user of stb_textedit.h leak their STB_TEXTEDIT_K_* symbols) +#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LEFT 0x200000 // keyboard input to move cursor left +#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_RIGHT 0x200001 // keyboard input to move cursor right +#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_UP 0x200002 // keyboard input to move cursor up +#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_DOWN 0x200003 // keyboard input to move cursor down +#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINESTART 0x200004 // keyboard input to move cursor to start of line +#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINEEND 0x200005 // keyboard input to move cursor to end of line +#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_TEXTSTART 0x200006 // keyboard input to move cursor to start of text +#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_TEXTEND 0x200007 // keyboard input to move cursor to end of text +#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_DELETE 0x200008 // keyboard input to delete selection or character under cursor +#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_BACKSPACE 0x200009 // keyboard input to delete selection or character left of cursor +#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_UNDO 0x20000A // keyboard input to perform undo +#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_REDO 0x20000B // keyboard input to perform redo +#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_WORDLEFT 0x20000C // keyboard input to move cursor left one word +#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_WORDRIGHT 0x20000D // keyboard input to move cursor right one word +#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_PGUP 0x20000E // keyboard input to move cursor up a page +#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_PGDOWN 0x20000F // keyboard input to move cursor down a page +#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT 0x400000 + +#define STB_TEXTEDIT_IMPLEMENTATION +#include "imstb_textedit.h" + +// stb_textedit internally allows for a single undo record to do addition and deletion, but somehow, calling +// the stb_textedit_paste() function creates two separate records, so we perform it manually. (FIXME: Report to nothings/stb?) +static void stb_textedit_replace(ImGuiInputTextState* str, STB_TexteditState* state, const STB_TEXTEDIT_CHARTYPE* text, int text_len) +{ + stb_text_makeundo_replace(str, state, 0, str->CurLenW, text_len); + ImStb::STB_TEXTEDIT_DELETECHARS(str, 0, str->CurLenW); + if (text_len <= 0) + return; + if (ImStb::STB_TEXTEDIT_INSERTCHARS(str, 0, text, text_len)) + { + state->cursor = text_len; + state->has_preferred_x = 0; + return; + } + IM_ASSERT(0); // Failed to insert character, normally shouldn't happen because of how we currently use stb_textedit_replace() +} + +} // namespace ImStb + +void ImGuiInputTextState::OnKeyPressed(int key) +{ + stb_textedit_key(this, &Stb, key); + CursorFollow = true; + CursorAnimReset(); +} + +ImGuiInputTextCallbackData::ImGuiInputTextCallbackData() +{ + memset(this, 0, sizeof(*this)); +} + +// Public API to manipulate UTF-8 text +// We expose UTF-8 to the user (unlike the STB_TEXTEDIT_* functions which are manipulating wchar) +// FIXME: The existence of this rarely exercised code path is a bit of a nuisance. +void ImGuiInputTextCallbackData::DeleteChars(int pos, int bytes_count) +{ + IM_ASSERT(pos + bytes_count <= BufTextLen); + char* dst = Buf + pos; + const char* src = Buf + pos + bytes_count; + while (char c = *src++) + *dst++ = c; + *dst = '\0'; + + if (CursorPos >= pos + bytes_count) + CursorPos -= bytes_count; + else if (CursorPos >= pos) + CursorPos = pos; + SelectionStart = SelectionEnd = CursorPos; + BufDirty = true; + BufTextLen -= bytes_count; +} + +void ImGuiInputTextCallbackData::InsertChars(int pos, const char* new_text, const char* new_text_end) +{ + const bool is_resizable = (Flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackResize) != 0; + const int new_text_len = new_text_end ? (int)(new_text_end - new_text) : (int)strlen(new_text); + if (new_text_len + BufTextLen >= BufSize) + { + if (!is_resizable) + return; + + // Contrary to STB_TEXTEDIT_INSERTCHARS() this is working in the UTF8 buffer, hence the mildly similar code (until we remove the U16 buffer altogether!) + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiInputTextState* edit_state = &g.InputTextState; + IM_ASSERT(edit_state->ID != 0 && g.ActiveId == edit_state->ID); + IM_ASSERT(Buf == edit_state->TextA.Data); + int new_buf_size = BufTextLen + ImClamp(new_text_len * 4, 32, ImMax(256, new_text_len)) + 1; + edit_state->TextA.reserve(new_buf_size + 1); + Buf = edit_state->TextA.Data; + BufSize = edit_state->BufCapacityA = new_buf_size; + } + + if (BufTextLen != pos) + memmove(Buf + pos + new_text_len, Buf + pos, (size_t)(BufTextLen - pos)); + memcpy(Buf + pos, new_text, (size_t)new_text_len * sizeof(char)); + Buf[BufTextLen + new_text_len] = '\0'; + + if (CursorPos >= pos) + CursorPos += new_text_len; + SelectionStart = SelectionEnd = CursorPos; + BufDirty = true; + BufTextLen += new_text_len; +} + +// Return false to discard a character. +static bool InputTextFilterCharacter(unsigned int* p_char, ImGuiInputTextFlags flags, ImGuiInputTextCallback callback, void* user_data, ImGuiInputSource input_source) +{ + IM_ASSERT(input_source == ImGuiInputSource_Keyboard || input_source == ImGuiInputSource_Clipboard); + unsigned int c = *p_char; + + // Filter non-printable (NB: isprint is unreliable! see #2467) + bool apply_named_filters = true; + if (c < 0x20) + { + bool pass = false; + pass |= (c == '\n' && (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_Multiline)); + pass |= (c == '\t' && (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_AllowTabInput)); + if (!pass) + return false; + apply_named_filters = false; // Override named filters below so newline and tabs can still be inserted. + } + + if (input_source != ImGuiInputSource_Clipboard) + { + // We ignore Ascii representation of delete (emitted from Backspace on OSX, see #2578, #2817) + if (c == 127) + return false; + + // Filter private Unicode range. GLFW on OSX seems to send private characters for special keys like arrow keys (FIXME) + if (c >= 0xE000 && c <= 0xF8FF) + return false; + } + + // Filter Unicode ranges we are not handling in this build + if (c > IM_UNICODE_CODEPOINT_MAX) + return false; + + // Generic named filters + if (apply_named_filters && (flags & (ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsDecimal | ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsHexadecimal | ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsUppercase | ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsNoBlank | ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsScientific))) + { + // The libc allows overriding locale, with e.g. 'setlocale(LC_NUMERIC, "de_DE.UTF-8");' which affect the output/input of printf/scanf. + // The standard mandate that programs starts in the "C" locale where the decimal point is '.'. + // We don't really intend to provide widespread support for it, but out of empathy for people stuck with using odd API, we support the bare minimum aka overriding the decimal point. + // Change the default decimal_point with: + // ImGui::GetCurrentContext()->PlatformLocaleDecimalPoint = *localeconv()->decimal_point; + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + const unsigned c_decimal_point = (unsigned int)g.PlatformLocaleDecimalPoint; + + // Allow 0-9 . - + * / + if (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsDecimal) + if (!(c >= '0' && c <= '9') && (c != c_decimal_point) && (c != '-') && (c != '+') && (c != '*') && (c != '/')) + return false; + + // Allow 0-9 . - + * / e E + if (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsScientific) + if (!(c >= '0' && c <= '9') && (c != c_decimal_point) && (c != '-') && (c != '+') && (c != '*') && (c != '/') && (c != 'e') && (c != 'E')) + return false; + + // Allow 0-9 a-F A-F + if (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsHexadecimal) + if (!(c >= '0' && c <= '9') && !(c >= 'a' && c <= 'f') && !(c >= 'A' && c <= 'F')) + return false; + + // Turn a-z into A-Z + if (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsUppercase) + if (c >= 'a' && c <= 'z') + *p_char = (c += (unsigned int)('A' - 'a')); + + if (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsNoBlank) + if (ImCharIsBlankW(c)) + return false; + } + + // Custom callback filter + if (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackCharFilter) + { + ImGuiInputTextCallbackData callback_data; + memset(&callback_data, 0, sizeof(ImGuiInputTextCallbackData)); + callback_data.EventFlag = ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackCharFilter; + callback_data.EventChar = (ImWchar)c; + callback_data.Flags = flags; + callback_data.UserData = user_data; + if (callback(&callback_data) != 0) + return false; + *p_char = callback_data.EventChar; + if (!callback_data.EventChar) + return false; + } + + return true; +} + +// Edit a string of text +// - buf_size account for the zero-terminator, so a buf_size of 6 can hold "Hello" but not "Hello!". +// This is so we can easily call InputText() on static arrays using ARRAYSIZE() and to match +// Note that in std::string world, capacity() would omit 1 byte used by the zero-terminator. +// - When active, hold on a privately held copy of the text (and apply back to 'buf'). So changing 'buf' while the InputText is active has no effect. +// - If you want to use ImGui::InputText() with std::string, see misc/cpp/imgui_stdlib.h +// (FIXME: Rather confusing and messy function, among the worse part of our codebase, expecting to rewrite a V2 at some point.. Partly because we are +// doing UTF8 > U16 > UTF8 conversions on the go to easily interface with stb_textedit. Ideally should stay in UTF-8 all the time. See https://github.com/nothings/stb/issues/188) +bool ImGui::InputTextEx(const char* label, const char* hint, char* buf, int buf_size, const ImVec2& size_arg, ImGuiInputTextFlags flags, ImGuiInputTextCallback callback, void* callback_user_data) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + if (window->SkipItems) + return false; + + IM_ASSERT(buf != NULL && buf_size >= 0); + IM_ASSERT(!((flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackHistory) && (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_Multiline))); // Can't use both together (they both use up/down keys) + IM_ASSERT(!((flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackCompletion) && (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_AllowTabInput))); // Can't use both together (they both use tab key) + + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiIO& io = g.IO; + const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style; + + const bool RENDER_SELECTION_WHEN_INACTIVE = false; + const bool is_multiline = (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_Multiline) != 0; + const bool is_readonly = (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_ReadOnly) != 0; + const bool is_password = (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_Password) != 0; + const bool is_undoable = (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_NoUndoRedo) == 0; + const bool is_resizable = (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackResize) != 0; + if (is_resizable) + IM_ASSERT(callback != NULL); // Must provide a callback if you set the ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackResize flag! + + if (is_multiline) // Open group before calling GetID() because groups tracks id created within their scope, + BeginGroup(); + const ImGuiID id = window->GetID(label); + const ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true); + const ImVec2 frame_size = CalcItemSize(size_arg, CalcItemWidth(), (is_multiline ? g.FontSize * 8.0f : label_size.y) + style.FramePadding.y * 2.0f); // Arbitrary default of 8 lines high for multi-line + const ImVec2 total_size = ImVec2(frame_size.x + (label_size.x > 0.0f ? style.ItemInnerSpacing.x + label_size.x : 0.0f), frame_size.y); + + const ImRect frame_bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + frame_size); + const ImRect total_bb(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Min + total_size); + + ImGuiWindow* draw_window = window; + ImVec2 inner_size = frame_size; + ImGuiItemStatusFlags item_status_flags = 0; + if (is_multiline) + { + if (!ItemAdd(total_bb, id, &frame_bb, ImGuiItemAddFlags_Focusable)) + { + ItemSize(total_bb, style.FramePadding.y); + EndGroup(); + return false; + } + item_status_flags = g.LastItemData.StatusFlags; + + // We reproduce the contents of BeginChildFrame() in order to provide 'label' so our window internal data are easier to read/debug. + PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_ChildBg, style.Colors[ImGuiCol_FrameBg]); + PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_ChildRounding, style.FrameRounding); + PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_ChildBorderSize, style.FrameBorderSize); + bool child_visible = BeginChildEx(label, id, frame_bb.GetSize(), true, ImGuiWindowFlags_NoMove); + PopStyleVar(2); + PopStyleColor(); + if (!child_visible) + { + EndChild(); + EndGroup(); + return false; + } + draw_window = g.CurrentWindow; // Child window + draw_window->DC.NavLayersActiveMaskNext |= (1 << draw_window->DC.NavLayerCurrent); // This is to ensure that EndChild() will display a navigation highlight so we can "enter" into it. + draw_window->DC.CursorPos += style.FramePadding; + inner_size.x -= draw_window->ScrollbarSizes.x; + } + else + { + // Support for internal ImGuiInputTextFlags_MergedItem flag, which could be redesigned as an ItemFlags if needed (with test performed in ItemAdd) + ItemSize(total_bb, style.FramePadding.y); + if (!(flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_MergedItem)) + if (!ItemAdd(total_bb, id, &frame_bb, ImGuiItemAddFlags_Focusable)) + return false; + item_status_flags = g.LastItemData.StatusFlags; + } + const bool hovered = ItemHoverable(frame_bb, id); + if (hovered) + g.MouseCursor = ImGuiMouseCursor_TextInput; + + // We are only allowed to access the state if we are already the active widget. + ImGuiInputTextState* state = GetInputTextState(id); + + const bool focus_requested_by_code = (item_status_flags & ImGuiItemStatusFlags_FocusedByCode) != 0; + const bool focus_requested_by_tabbing = (item_status_flags & ImGuiItemStatusFlags_FocusedByTabbing) != 0; + + const bool user_clicked = hovered && io.MouseClicked[0]; + const bool user_nav_input_start = (g.ActiveId != id) && ((g.NavInputId == id) || (g.NavActivateId == id && g.NavInputSource == ImGuiInputSource_Keyboard)); + const bool user_scroll_finish = is_multiline && state != NULL && g.ActiveId == 0 && g.ActiveIdPreviousFrame == GetWindowScrollbarID(draw_window, ImGuiAxis_Y); + const bool user_scroll_active = is_multiline && state != NULL && g.ActiveId == GetWindowScrollbarID(draw_window, ImGuiAxis_Y); + + bool clear_active_id = false; + bool select_all = (g.ActiveId != id) && ((flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_AutoSelectAll) != 0 || user_nav_input_start) && (!is_multiline); + + float scroll_y = is_multiline ? draw_window->Scroll.y : FLT_MAX; + + const bool init_changed_specs = (state != NULL && state->Stb.single_line != !is_multiline); + const bool init_make_active = (user_clicked || user_scroll_finish || user_nav_input_start || focus_requested_by_code || focus_requested_by_tabbing); + const bool init_state = (init_make_active || user_scroll_active); + if ((init_state && g.ActiveId != id) || init_changed_specs) + { + // Access state even if we don't own it yet. + state = &g.InputTextState; + state->CursorAnimReset(); + + // Take a copy of the initial buffer value (both in original UTF-8 format and converted to wchar) + // From the moment we focused we are ignoring the content of 'buf' (unless we are in read-only mode) + const int buf_len = (int)strlen(buf); + state->InitialTextA.resize(buf_len + 1); // UTF-8. we use +1 to make sure that .Data is always pointing to at least an empty string. + memcpy(state->InitialTextA.Data, buf, buf_len + 1); + + // Start edition + const char* buf_end = NULL; + state->TextW.resize(buf_size + 1); // wchar count <= UTF-8 count. we use +1 to make sure that .Data is always pointing to at least an empty string. + state->TextA.resize(0); + state->TextAIsValid = false; // TextA is not valid yet (we will display buf until then) + state->CurLenW = ImTextStrFromUtf8(state->TextW.Data, buf_size, buf, NULL, &buf_end); + state->CurLenA = (int)(buf_end - buf); // We can't get the result from ImStrncpy() above because it is not UTF-8 aware. Here we'll cut off malformed UTF-8. + + // Preserve cursor position and undo/redo stack if we come back to same widget + // FIXME: For non-readonly widgets we might be able to require that TextAIsValid && TextA == buf ? (untested) and discard undo stack if user buffer has changed. + const bool recycle_state = (state->ID == id && !init_changed_specs); + if (recycle_state) + { + // Recycle existing cursor/selection/undo stack but clamp position + // Note a single mouse click will override the cursor/position immediately by calling stb_textedit_click handler. + state->CursorClamp(); + } + else + { + state->ID = id; + state->ScrollX = 0.0f; + stb_textedit_initialize_state(&state->Stb, !is_multiline); + if (!is_multiline && focus_requested_by_code) + select_all = true; + } + if (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_AlwaysOverwrite) + state->Stb.insert_mode = 1; // stb field name is indeed incorrect (see #2863) + if (!is_multiline && (focus_requested_by_tabbing || (user_clicked && io.KeyCtrl))) + select_all = true; + } + + if (g.ActiveId != id && init_make_active) + { + IM_ASSERT(state && state->ID == id); + SetActiveID(id, window); + SetFocusID(id, window); + FocusWindow(window); + + // Declare our inputs + IM_ASSERT(ImGuiNavInput_COUNT < 32); + g.ActiveIdUsingNavDirMask |= (1 << ImGuiDir_Left) | (1 << ImGuiDir_Right); + if (is_multiline || (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackHistory)) + g.ActiveIdUsingNavDirMask |= (1 << ImGuiDir_Up) | (1 << ImGuiDir_Down); + g.ActiveIdUsingNavInputMask |= (1 << ImGuiNavInput_Cancel); + g.ActiveIdUsingKeyInputMask |= ((ImU64)1 << ImGuiKey_Home) | ((ImU64)1 << ImGuiKey_End); + if (is_multiline) + g.ActiveIdUsingKeyInputMask |= ((ImU64)1 << ImGuiKey_PageUp) | ((ImU64)1 << ImGuiKey_PageDown); + if (flags & (ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackCompletion | ImGuiInputTextFlags_AllowTabInput)) // Disable keyboard tabbing out as we will use the \t character. + g.ActiveIdUsingKeyInputMask |= ((ImU64)1 << ImGuiKey_Tab); + } + + // We have an edge case if ActiveId was set through another widget (e.g. widget being swapped), clear id immediately (don't wait until the end of the function) + if (g.ActiveId == id && state == NULL) + ClearActiveID(); + + // Release focus when we click outside + if (g.ActiveId == id && io.MouseClicked[0] && !init_state && !init_make_active) //-V560 + clear_active_id = true; + + // Lock the decision of whether we are going to take the path displaying the cursor or selection + const bool render_cursor = (g.ActiveId == id) || (state && user_scroll_active); + bool render_selection = state && state->HasSelection() && (RENDER_SELECTION_WHEN_INACTIVE || render_cursor); + bool value_changed = false; + bool enter_pressed = false; + + // When read-only we always use the live data passed to the function + // FIXME-OPT: Because our selection/cursor code currently needs the wide text we need to convert it when active, which is not ideal :( + if (is_readonly && state != NULL && (render_cursor || render_selection)) + { + const char* buf_end = NULL; + state->TextW.resize(buf_size + 1); + state->CurLenW = ImTextStrFromUtf8(state->TextW.Data, state->TextW.Size, buf, NULL, &buf_end); + state->CurLenA = (int)(buf_end - buf); + state->CursorClamp(); + render_selection &= state->HasSelection(); + } + + // Select the buffer to render. + const bool buf_display_from_state = (render_cursor || render_selection || g.ActiveId == id) && !is_readonly && state && state->TextAIsValid; + const bool is_displaying_hint = (hint != NULL && (buf_display_from_state ? state->TextA.Data : buf)[0] == 0); + + // Password pushes a temporary font with only a fallback glyph + if (is_password && !is_displaying_hint) + { + const ImFontGlyph* glyph = g.Font->FindGlyph('*'); + ImFont* password_font = &g.InputTextPasswordFont; + password_font->FontSize = g.Font->FontSize; + password_font->Scale = g.Font->Scale; + password_font->Ascent = g.Font->Ascent; + password_font->Descent = g.Font->Descent; + password_font->ContainerAtlas = g.Font->ContainerAtlas; + password_font->FallbackGlyph = glyph; + password_font->FallbackAdvanceX = glyph->AdvanceX; + IM_ASSERT(password_font->Glyphs.empty() && password_font->IndexAdvanceX.empty() && password_font->IndexLookup.empty()); + PushFont(password_font); + } + + // Process mouse inputs and character inputs + int backup_current_text_length = 0; + if (g.ActiveId == id) + { + IM_ASSERT(state != NULL); + backup_current_text_length = state->CurLenA; + state->Edited = false; + state->BufCapacityA = buf_size; + state->Flags = flags; + state->UserCallback = callback; + state->UserCallbackData = callback_user_data; + + // Although we are active we don't prevent mouse from hovering other elements unless we are interacting right now with the widget. + // Down the line we should have a cleaner library-wide concept of Selected vs Active. + g.ActiveIdAllowOverlap = !io.MouseDown[0]; + g.WantTextInputNextFrame = 1; + + // Edit in progress + const float mouse_x = (io.MousePos.x - frame_bb.Min.x - style.FramePadding.x) + state->ScrollX; + const float mouse_y = (is_multiline ? (io.MousePos.y - draw_window->DC.CursorPos.y) : (g.FontSize * 0.5f)); + + const bool is_osx = io.ConfigMacOSXBehaviors; + if (select_all || (hovered && !is_osx && io.MouseDoubleClicked[0])) + { + state->SelectAll(); + state->SelectedAllMouseLock = true; + } + else if (hovered && is_osx && io.MouseDoubleClicked[0]) + { + // Double-click select a word only, OS X style (by simulating keystrokes) + state->OnKeyPressed(STB_TEXTEDIT_K_WORDLEFT); + state->OnKeyPressed(STB_TEXTEDIT_K_WORDRIGHT | STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT); + } + else if (io.MouseClicked[0] && !state->SelectedAllMouseLock) + { + if (hovered) + { + stb_textedit_click(state, &state->Stb, mouse_x, mouse_y); + state->CursorAnimReset(); + } + } + else if (io.MouseDown[0] && !state->SelectedAllMouseLock && (io.MouseDelta.x != 0.0f || io.MouseDelta.y != 0.0f)) + { + stb_textedit_drag(state, &state->Stb, mouse_x, mouse_y); + state->CursorAnimReset(); + state->CursorFollow = true; + } + if (state->SelectedAllMouseLock && !io.MouseDown[0]) + state->SelectedAllMouseLock = false; + + // It is ill-defined whether the backend needs to send a \t character when pressing the TAB keys. + // Win32 and GLFW naturally do it but not SDL. + const bool ignore_char_inputs = (io.KeyCtrl && !io.KeyAlt) || (is_osx && io.KeySuper); + if ((flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_AllowTabInput) && IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_Tab) && !ignore_char_inputs && !io.KeyShift && !is_readonly) + if (!io.InputQueueCharacters.contains('\t')) + { + unsigned int c = '\t'; // Insert TAB + if (InputTextFilterCharacter(&c, flags, callback, callback_user_data, ImGuiInputSource_Keyboard)) + state->OnKeyPressed((int)c); + } + + // Process regular text input (before we check for Return because using some IME will effectively send a Return?) + // We ignore CTRL inputs, but need to allow ALT+CTRL as some keyboards (e.g. German) use AltGR (which _is_ Alt+Ctrl) to input certain characters. + if (io.InputQueueCharacters.Size > 0) + { + if (!ignore_char_inputs && !is_readonly && !user_nav_input_start) + for (int n = 0; n < io.InputQueueCharacters.Size; n++) + { + // Insert character if they pass filtering + unsigned int c = (unsigned int)io.InputQueueCharacters[n]; + if (c == '\t' && io.KeyShift) + continue; + if (InputTextFilterCharacter(&c, flags, callback, callback_user_data, ImGuiInputSource_Keyboard)) + state->OnKeyPressed((int)c); + } + + // Consume characters + io.InputQueueCharacters.resize(0); + } + } + + // Process other shortcuts/key-presses + bool cancel_edit = false; + if (g.ActiveId == id && !g.ActiveIdIsJustActivated && !clear_active_id) + { + IM_ASSERT(state != NULL); + IM_ASSERT(io.KeyMods == GetMergedKeyModFlags() && "Mismatching io.KeyCtrl/io.KeyShift/io.KeyAlt/io.KeySuper vs io.KeyMods"); // We rarely do this check, but if anything let's do it here. + + const int row_count_per_page = ImMax((int)((inner_size.y - style.FramePadding.y) / g.FontSize), 1); + state->Stb.row_count_per_page = row_count_per_page; + + const int k_mask = (io.KeyShift ? STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT : 0); + const bool is_osx = io.ConfigMacOSXBehaviors; + const bool is_osx_shift_shortcut = is_osx && (io.KeyMods == (ImGuiKeyModFlags_Super | ImGuiKeyModFlags_Shift)); + const bool is_wordmove_key_down = is_osx ? io.KeyAlt : io.KeyCtrl; // OS X style: Text editing cursor movement using Alt instead of Ctrl + const bool is_startend_key_down = is_osx && io.KeySuper && !io.KeyCtrl && !io.KeyAlt; // OS X style: Line/Text Start and End using Cmd+Arrows instead of Home/End + const bool is_ctrl_key_only = (io.KeyMods == ImGuiKeyModFlags_Ctrl); + const bool is_shift_key_only = (io.KeyMods == ImGuiKeyModFlags_Shift); + const bool is_shortcut_key = g.IO.ConfigMacOSXBehaviors ? (io.KeyMods == ImGuiKeyModFlags_Super) : (io.KeyMods == ImGuiKeyModFlags_Ctrl); + + const bool is_cut = ((is_shortcut_key && IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_X)) || (is_shift_key_only && IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_Delete))) && !is_readonly && !is_password && (!is_multiline || state->HasSelection()); + const bool is_copy = ((is_shortcut_key && IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_C)) || (is_ctrl_key_only && IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_Insert))) && !is_password && (!is_multiline || state->HasSelection()); + const bool is_paste = ((is_shortcut_key && IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_V)) || (is_shift_key_only && IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_Insert))) && !is_readonly; + const bool is_undo = ((is_shortcut_key && IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_Z)) && !is_readonly && is_undoable); + const bool is_redo = ((is_shortcut_key && IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_Y)) || (is_osx_shift_shortcut && IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_Z))) && !is_readonly && is_undoable; + + if (IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_LeftArrow)) { state->OnKeyPressed((is_startend_key_down ? STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINESTART : is_wordmove_key_down ? STB_TEXTEDIT_K_WORDLEFT : STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LEFT) | k_mask); } + else if (IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_RightArrow)) { state->OnKeyPressed((is_startend_key_down ? STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINEEND : is_wordmove_key_down ? STB_TEXTEDIT_K_WORDRIGHT : STB_TEXTEDIT_K_RIGHT) | k_mask); } + else if (IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_UpArrow) && is_multiline) { if (io.KeyCtrl) SetScrollY(draw_window, ImMax(draw_window->Scroll.y - g.FontSize, 0.0f)); else state->OnKeyPressed((is_startend_key_down ? STB_TEXTEDIT_K_TEXTSTART : STB_TEXTEDIT_K_UP) | k_mask); } + else if (IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_DownArrow) && is_multiline) { if (io.KeyCtrl) SetScrollY(draw_window, ImMin(draw_window->Scroll.y + g.FontSize, GetScrollMaxY())); else state->OnKeyPressed((is_startend_key_down ? STB_TEXTEDIT_K_TEXTEND : STB_TEXTEDIT_K_DOWN) | k_mask); } + else if (IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_PageUp) && is_multiline) { state->OnKeyPressed(STB_TEXTEDIT_K_PGUP | k_mask); scroll_y -= row_count_per_page * g.FontSize; } + else if (IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_PageDown) && is_multiline) { state->OnKeyPressed(STB_TEXTEDIT_K_PGDOWN | k_mask); scroll_y += row_count_per_page * g.FontSize; } + else if (IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_Home)) { state->OnKeyPressed(io.KeyCtrl ? STB_TEXTEDIT_K_TEXTSTART | k_mask : STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINESTART | k_mask); } + else if (IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_End)) { state->OnKeyPressed(io.KeyCtrl ? STB_TEXTEDIT_K_TEXTEND | k_mask : STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINEEND | k_mask); } + else if (IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_Delete) && !is_readonly) { state->OnKeyPressed(STB_TEXTEDIT_K_DELETE | k_mask); } + else if (IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_Backspace) && !is_readonly) + { + if (!state->HasSelection()) + { + if (is_wordmove_key_down) + state->OnKeyPressed(STB_TEXTEDIT_K_WORDLEFT | STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT); + else if (is_osx && io.KeySuper && !io.KeyAlt && !io.KeyCtrl) + state->OnKeyPressed(STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINESTART | STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT); + } + state->OnKeyPressed(STB_TEXTEDIT_K_BACKSPACE | k_mask); + } + else if (IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_Enter) || IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_KeyPadEnter)) + { + bool ctrl_enter_for_new_line = (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CtrlEnterForNewLine) != 0; + if (!is_multiline || (ctrl_enter_for_new_line && !io.KeyCtrl) || (!ctrl_enter_for_new_line && io.KeyCtrl)) + { + enter_pressed = clear_active_id = true; + } + else if (!is_readonly) + { + unsigned int c = '\n'; // Insert new line + if (InputTextFilterCharacter(&c, flags, callback, callback_user_data, ImGuiInputSource_Keyboard)) + state->OnKeyPressed((int)c); + } + } + else if (IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_Escape)) + { + clear_active_id = cancel_edit = true; + } + else if (is_undo || is_redo) + { + state->OnKeyPressed(is_undo ? STB_TEXTEDIT_K_UNDO : STB_TEXTEDIT_K_REDO); + state->ClearSelection(); + } + else if (is_shortcut_key && IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_A)) + { + state->SelectAll(); + state->CursorFollow = true; + } + else if (is_cut || is_copy) + { + // Cut, Copy + if (io.SetClipboardTextFn) + { + const int ib = state->HasSelection() ? ImMin(state->Stb.select_start, state->Stb.select_end) : 0; + const int ie = state->HasSelection() ? ImMax(state->Stb.select_start, state->Stb.select_end) : state->CurLenW; + const int clipboard_data_len = ImTextCountUtf8BytesFromStr(state->TextW.Data + ib, state->TextW.Data + ie) + 1; + char* clipboard_data = (char*)IM_ALLOC(clipboard_data_len * sizeof(char)); + ImTextStrToUtf8(clipboard_data, clipboard_data_len, state->TextW.Data + ib, state->TextW.Data + ie); + SetClipboardText(clipboard_data); + MemFree(clipboard_data); + } + if (is_cut) + { + if (!state->HasSelection()) + state->SelectAll(); + state->CursorFollow = true; + stb_textedit_cut(state, &state->Stb); + } + } + else if (is_paste) + { + if (const char* clipboard = GetClipboardText()) + { + // Filter pasted buffer + const int clipboard_len = (int)strlen(clipboard); + ImWchar* clipboard_filtered = (ImWchar*)IM_ALLOC((clipboard_len + 1) * sizeof(ImWchar)); + int clipboard_filtered_len = 0; + for (const char* s = clipboard; *s; ) + { + unsigned int c; + s += ImTextCharFromUtf8(&c, s, NULL); + if (c == 0) + break; + if (!InputTextFilterCharacter(&c, flags, callback, callback_user_data, ImGuiInputSource_Clipboard)) + continue; + clipboard_filtered[clipboard_filtered_len++] = (ImWchar)c; + } + clipboard_filtered[clipboard_filtered_len] = 0; + if (clipboard_filtered_len > 0) // If everything was filtered, ignore the pasting operation + { + stb_textedit_paste(state, &state->Stb, clipboard_filtered, clipboard_filtered_len); + state->CursorFollow = true; + } + MemFree(clipboard_filtered); + } + } + + // Update render selection flag after events have been handled, so selection highlight can be displayed during the same frame. + render_selection |= state->HasSelection() && (RENDER_SELECTION_WHEN_INACTIVE || render_cursor); + } + + // Process callbacks and apply result back to user's buffer. + if (g.ActiveId == id) + { + IM_ASSERT(state != NULL); + const char* apply_new_text = NULL; + int apply_new_text_length = 0; + if (cancel_edit) + { + // Restore initial value. Only return true if restoring to the initial value changes the current buffer contents. + if (!is_readonly && strcmp(buf, state->InitialTextA.Data) != 0) + { + // Push records into the undo stack so we can CTRL+Z the revert operation itself + apply_new_text = state->InitialTextA.Data; + apply_new_text_length = state->InitialTextA.Size - 1; + ImVector w_text; + if (apply_new_text_length > 0) + { + w_text.resize(ImTextCountCharsFromUtf8(apply_new_text, apply_new_text + apply_new_text_length) + 1); + ImTextStrFromUtf8(w_text.Data, w_text.Size, apply_new_text, apply_new_text + apply_new_text_length); + } + stb_textedit_replace(state, &state->Stb, w_text.Data, (apply_new_text_length > 0) ? (w_text.Size - 1) : 0); + } + } + + // When using 'ImGuiInputTextFlags_EnterReturnsTrue' as a special case we reapply the live buffer back to the input buffer before clearing ActiveId, even though strictly speaking it wasn't modified on this frame. + // If we didn't do that, code like InputInt() with ImGuiInputTextFlags_EnterReturnsTrue would fail. + // This also allows the user to use InputText() with ImGuiInputTextFlags_EnterReturnsTrue without maintaining any user-side storage (please note that if you use this property along ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackResize you can end up with your temporary string object unnecessarily allocating once a frame, either store your string data, either if you don't then don't use ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackResize). + bool apply_edit_back_to_user_buffer = !cancel_edit || (enter_pressed && (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_EnterReturnsTrue) != 0); + if (apply_edit_back_to_user_buffer) + { + // Apply new value immediately - copy modified buffer back + // Note that as soon as the input box is active, the in-widget value gets priority over any underlying modification of the input buffer + // FIXME: We actually always render 'buf' when calling DrawList->AddText, making the comment above incorrect. + // FIXME-OPT: CPU waste to do this every time the widget is active, should mark dirty state from the stb_textedit callbacks. + if (!is_readonly) + { + state->TextAIsValid = true; + state->TextA.resize(state->TextW.Size * 4 + 1); + ImTextStrToUtf8(state->TextA.Data, state->TextA.Size, state->TextW.Data, NULL); + } + + // User callback + if ((flags & (ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackCompletion | ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackHistory | ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackEdit | ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackAlways)) != 0) + { + IM_ASSERT(callback != NULL); + + // The reason we specify the usage semantic (Completion/History) is that Completion needs to disable keyboard TABBING at the moment. + ImGuiInputTextFlags event_flag = 0; + ImGuiKey event_key = ImGuiKey_COUNT; + if ((flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackCompletion) != 0 && IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_Tab)) + { + event_flag = ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackCompletion; + event_key = ImGuiKey_Tab; + } + else if ((flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackHistory) != 0 && IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_UpArrow)) + { + event_flag = ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackHistory; + event_key = ImGuiKey_UpArrow; + } + else if ((flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackHistory) != 0 && IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_DownArrow)) + { + event_flag = ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackHistory; + event_key = ImGuiKey_DownArrow; + } + else if ((flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackEdit) && state->Edited) + { + event_flag = ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackEdit; + } + else if (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackAlways) + { + event_flag = ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackAlways; + } + + if (event_flag) + { + ImGuiInputTextCallbackData callback_data; + memset(&callback_data, 0, sizeof(ImGuiInputTextCallbackData)); + callback_data.EventFlag = event_flag; + callback_data.Flags = flags; + callback_data.UserData = callback_user_data; + + callback_data.EventKey = event_key; + callback_data.Buf = state->TextA.Data; + callback_data.BufTextLen = state->CurLenA; + callback_data.BufSize = state->BufCapacityA; + callback_data.BufDirty = false; + + // We have to convert from wchar-positions to UTF-8-positions, which can be pretty slow (an incentive to ditch the ImWchar buffer, see https://github.com/nothings/stb/issues/188) + ImWchar* text = state->TextW.Data; + const int utf8_cursor_pos = callback_data.CursorPos = ImTextCountUtf8BytesFromStr(text, text + state->Stb.cursor); + const int utf8_selection_start = callback_data.SelectionStart = ImTextCountUtf8BytesFromStr(text, text + state->Stb.select_start); + const int utf8_selection_end = callback_data.SelectionEnd = ImTextCountUtf8BytesFromStr(text, text + state->Stb.select_end); + + // Call user code + callback(&callback_data); + + // Read back what user may have modified + IM_ASSERT(callback_data.Buf == state->TextA.Data); // Invalid to modify those fields + IM_ASSERT(callback_data.BufSize == state->BufCapacityA); + IM_ASSERT(callback_data.Flags == flags); + const bool buf_dirty = callback_data.BufDirty; + if (callback_data.CursorPos != utf8_cursor_pos || buf_dirty) { state->Stb.cursor = ImTextCountCharsFromUtf8(callback_data.Buf, callback_data.Buf + callback_data.CursorPos); state->CursorFollow = true; } + if (callback_data.SelectionStart != utf8_selection_start || buf_dirty) { state->Stb.select_start = (callback_data.SelectionStart == callback_data.CursorPos) ? state->Stb.cursor : ImTextCountCharsFromUtf8(callback_data.Buf, callback_data.Buf + callback_data.SelectionStart); } + if (callback_data.SelectionEnd != utf8_selection_end || buf_dirty) { state->Stb.select_end = (callback_data.SelectionEnd == callback_data.SelectionStart) ? state->Stb.select_start : ImTextCountCharsFromUtf8(callback_data.Buf, callback_data.Buf + callback_data.SelectionEnd); } + if (buf_dirty) + { + IM_ASSERT(callback_data.BufTextLen == (int)strlen(callback_data.Buf)); // You need to maintain BufTextLen if you change the text! + if (callback_data.BufTextLen > backup_current_text_length && is_resizable) + state->TextW.resize(state->TextW.Size + (callback_data.BufTextLen - backup_current_text_length)); + state->CurLenW = ImTextStrFromUtf8(state->TextW.Data, state->TextW.Size, callback_data.Buf, NULL); + state->CurLenA = callback_data.BufTextLen; // Assume correct length and valid UTF-8 from user, saves us an extra strlen() + state->CursorAnimReset(); + } + } + } + + // Will copy result string if modified + if (!is_readonly && strcmp(state->TextA.Data, buf) != 0) + { + apply_new_text = state->TextA.Data; + apply_new_text_length = state->CurLenA; + } + } + + // Copy result to user buffer + if (apply_new_text) + { + // We cannot test for 'backup_current_text_length != apply_new_text_length' here because we have no guarantee that the size + // of our owned buffer matches the size of the string object held by the user, and by design we allow InputText() to be used + // without any storage on user's side. + IM_ASSERT(apply_new_text_length >= 0); + if (is_resizable) + { + ImGuiInputTextCallbackData callback_data; + callback_data.EventFlag = ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackResize; + callback_data.Flags = flags; + callback_data.Buf = buf; + callback_data.BufTextLen = apply_new_text_length; + callback_data.BufSize = ImMax(buf_size, apply_new_text_length + 1); + callback_data.UserData = callback_user_data; + callback(&callback_data); + buf = callback_data.Buf; + buf_size = callback_data.BufSize; + apply_new_text_length = ImMin(callback_data.BufTextLen, buf_size - 1); + IM_ASSERT(apply_new_text_length <= buf_size); + } + //IMGUI_DEBUG_LOG("InputText(\"%s\"): apply_new_text length %d\n", label, apply_new_text_length); + + // If the underlying buffer resize was denied or not carried to the next frame, apply_new_text_length+1 may be >= buf_size. + ImStrncpy(buf, apply_new_text, ImMin(apply_new_text_length + 1, buf_size)); + value_changed = true; + } + + // Clear temporary user storage + state->Flags = ImGuiInputTextFlags_None; + state->UserCallback = NULL; + state->UserCallbackData = NULL; + } + + // Release active ID at the end of the function (so e.g. pressing Return still does a final application of the value) + if (clear_active_id && g.ActiveId == id) + ClearActiveID(); + + // Render frame + if (!is_multiline) + { + RenderNavHighlight(frame_bb, id); + RenderFrame(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_FrameBg), true, style.FrameRounding); + } + + const ImVec4 clip_rect(frame_bb.Min.x, frame_bb.Min.y, frame_bb.Min.x + inner_size.x, frame_bb.Min.y + inner_size.y); // Not using frame_bb.Max because we have adjusted size + ImVec2 draw_pos = is_multiline ? draw_window->DC.CursorPos : frame_bb.Min + style.FramePadding; + ImVec2 text_size(0.0f, 0.0f); + + // Set upper limit of single-line InputTextEx() at 2 million characters strings. The current pathological worst case is a long line + // without any carriage return, which would makes ImFont::RenderText() reserve too many vertices and probably crash. Avoid it altogether. + // Note that we only use this limit on single-line InputText(), so a pathologically large line on a InputTextMultiline() would still crash. + const int buf_display_max_length = 2 * 1024 * 1024; + const char* buf_display = buf_display_from_state ? state->TextA.Data : buf; //-V595 + const char* buf_display_end = NULL; // We have specialized paths below for setting the length + if (is_displaying_hint) + { + buf_display = hint; + buf_display_end = hint + strlen(hint); + } + + // Render text. We currently only render selection when the widget is active or while scrolling. + // FIXME: We could remove the '&& render_cursor' to keep rendering selection when inactive. + if (render_cursor || render_selection) + { + IM_ASSERT(state != NULL); + if (!is_displaying_hint) + buf_display_end = buf_display + state->CurLenA; + + // Render text (with cursor and selection) + // This is going to be messy. We need to: + // - Display the text (this alone can be more easily clipped) + // - Handle scrolling, highlight selection, display cursor (those all requires some form of 1d->2d cursor position calculation) + // - Measure text height (for scrollbar) + // We are attempting to do most of that in **one main pass** to minimize the computation cost (non-negligible for large amount of text) + 2nd pass for selection rendering (we could merge them by an extra refactoring effort) + // FIXME: This should occur on buf_display but we'd need to maintain cursor/select_start/select_end for UTF-8. + const ImWchar* text_begin = state->TextW.Data; + ImVec2 cursor_offset, select_start_offset; + + { + // Find lines numbers straddling 'cursor' (slot 0) and 'select_start' (slot 1) positions. + const ImWchar* searches_input_ptr[2] = { NULL, NULL }; + int searches_result_line_no[2] = { -1000, -1000 }; + int searches_remaining = 0; + if (render_cursor) + { + searches_input_ptr[0] = text_begin + state->Stb.cursor; + searches_result_line_no[0] = -1; + searches_remaining++; + } + if (render_selection) + { + searches_input_ptr[1] = text_begin + ImMin(state->Stb.select_start, state->Stb.select_end); + searches_result_line_no[1] = -1; + searches_remaining++; + } + + // Iterate all lines to find our line numbers + // In multi-line mode, we never exit the loop until all lines are counted, so add one extra to the searches_remaining counter. + searches_remaining += is_multiline ? 1 : 0; + int line_count = 0; + //for (const ImWchar* s = text_begin; (s = (const ImWchar*)wcschr((const wchar_t*)s, (wchar_t)'\n')) != NULL; s++) // FIXME-OPT: Could use this when wchar_t are 16-bit + for (const ImWchar* s = text_begin; *s != 0; s++) + if (*s == '\n') + { + line_count++; + if (searches_result_line_no[0] == -1 && s >= searches_input_ptr[0]) { searches_result_line_no[0] = line_count; if (--searches_remaining <= 0) break; } + if (searches_result_line_no[1] == -1 && s >= searches_input_ptr[1]) { searches_result_line_no[1] = line_count; if (--searches_remaining <= 0) break; } + } + line_count++; + if (searches_result_line_no[0] == -1) + searches_result_line_no[0] = line_count; + if (searches_result_line_no[1] == -1) + searches_result_line_no[1] = line_count; + + // Calculate 2d position by finding the beginning of the line and measuring distance + cursor_offset.x = InputTextCalcTextSizeW(ImStrbolW(searches_input_ptr[0], text_begin), searches_input_ptr[0]).x; + cursor_offset.y = searches_result_line_no[0] * g.FontSize; + if (searches_result_line_no[1] >= 0) + { + select_start_offset.x = InputTextCalcTextSizeW(ImStrbolW(searches_input_ptr[1], text_begin), searches_input_ptr[1]).x; + select_start_offset.y = searches_result_line_no[1] * g.FontSize; + } + + // Store text height (note that we haven't calculated text width at all, see GitHub issues #383, #1224) + if (is_multiline) + text_size = ImVec2(inner_size.x, line_count * g.FontSize); + } + + // Scroll + if (render_cursor && state->CursorFollow) + { + // Horizontal scroll in chunks of quarter width + if (!(flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_NoHorizontalScroll)) + { + const float scroll_increment_x = inner_size.x * 0.25f; + const float visible_width = inner_size.x - style.FramePadding.x; + if (cursor_offset.x < state->ScrollX) + state->ScrollX = IM_FLOOR(ImMax(0.0f, cursor_offset.x - scroll_increment_x)); + else if (cursor_offset.x - visible_width >= state->ScrollX) + state->ScrollX = IM_FLOOR(cursor_offset.x - visible_width + scroll_increment_x); + } + else + { + state->ScrollX = 0.0f; + } + + // Vertical scroll + if (is_multiline) + { + // Test if cursor is vertically visible + if (cursor_offset.y - g.FontSize < scroll_y) + scroll_y = ImMax(0.0f, cursor_offset.y - g.FontSize); + else if (cursor_offset.y - inner_size.y >= scroll_y) + scroll_y = cursor_offset.y - inner_size.y + style.FramePadding.y * 2.0f; + const float scroll_max_y = ImMax((text_size.y + style.FramePadding.y * 2.0f) - inner_size.y, 0.0f); + scroll_y = ImClamp(scroll_y, 0.0f, scroll_max_y); + draw_pos.y += (draw_window->Scroll.y - scroll_y); // Manipulate cursor pos immediately avoid a frame of lag + draw_window->Scroll.y = scroll_y; + } + + state->CursorFollow = false; + } + + // Draw selection + const ImVec2 draw_scroll = ImVec2(state->ScrollX, 0.0f); + if (render_selection) + { + const ImWchar* text_selected_begin = text_begin + ImMin(state->Stb.select_start, state->Stb.select_end); + const ImWchar* text_selected_end = text_begin + ImMax(state->Stb.select_start, state->Stb.select_end); + + ImU32 bg_color = GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_TextSelectedBg, render_cursor ? 1.0f : 0.6f); // FIXME: current code flow mandate that render_cursor is always true here, we are leaving the transparent one for tests. + float bg_offy_up = is_multiline ? 0.0f : -1.0f; // FIXME: those offsets should be part of the style? they don't play so well with multi-line selection. + float bg_offy_dn = is_multiline ? 0.0f : 2.0f; + ImVec2 rect_pos = draw_pos + select_start_offset - draw_scroll; + for (const ImWchar* p = text_selected_begin; p < text_selected_end; ) + { + if (rect_pos.y > clip_rect.w + g.FontSize) + break; + if (rect_pos.y < clip_rect.y) + { + //p = (const ImWchar*)wmemchr((const wchar_t*)p, '\n', text_selected_end - p); // FIXME-OPT: Could use this when wchar_t are 16-bit + //p = p ? p + 1 : text_selected_end; + while (p < text_selected_end) + if (*p++ == '\n') + break; + } + else + { + ImVec2 rect_size = InputTextCalcTextSizeW(p, text_selected_end, &p, NULL, true); + if (rect_size.x <= 0.0f) rect_size.x = IM_FLOOR(g.Font->GetCharAdvance((ImWchar)' ') * 0.50f); // So we can see selected empty lines + ImRect rect(rect_pos + ImVec2(0.0f, bg_offy_up - g.FontSize), rect_pos + ImVec2(rect_size.x, bg_offy_dn)); + rect.ClipWith(clip_rect); + if (rect.Overlaps(clip_rect)) + draw_window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(rect.Min, rect.Max, bg_color); + } + rect_pos.x = draw_pos.x - draw_scroll.x; + rect_pos.y += g.FontSize; + } + } + + // We test for 'buf_display_max_length' as a way to avoid some pathological cases (e.g. single-line 1 MB string) which would make ImDrawList crash. + if (is_multiline || (buf_display_end - buf_display) < buf_display_max_length) + { + ImU32 col = GetColorU32(is_displaying_hint ? ImGuiCol_TextDisabled : ImGuiCol_Text); + draw_window->DrawList->AddText(g.Font, g.FontSize, draw_pos - draw_scroll, col, buf_display, buf_display_end, 0.0f, is_multiline ? NULL : &clip_rect); + } + + // Draw blinking cursor + if (render_cursor) + { + state->CursorAnim += io.DeltaTime; + bool cursor_is_visible = (!g.IO.ConfigInputTextCursorBlink) || (state->CursorAnim <= 0.0f) || ImFmod(state->CursorAnim, 1.20f) <= 0.80f; + ImVec2 cursor_screen_pos = ImFloor(draw_pos + cursor_offset - draw_scroll); + ImRect cursor_screen_rect(cursor_screen_pos.x, cursor_screen_pos.y - g.FontSize + 0.5f, cursor_screen_pos.x + 1.0f, cursor_screen_pos.y - 1.5f); + if (cursor_is_visible && cursor_screen_rect.Overlaps(clip_rect)) + draw_window->DrawList->AddLine(cursor_screen_rect.Min, cursor_screen_rect.GetBL(), GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text)); + + // Notify OS of text input position for advanced IME (-1 x offset so that Windows IME can cover our cursor. Bit of an extra nicety.) + if (!is_readonly) + g.PlatformImePos = ImVec2(cursor_screen_pos.x - 1.0f, cursor_screen_pos.y - g.FontSize); + } + } + else + { + // Render text only (no selection, no cursor) + if (is_multiline) + text_size = ImVec2(inner_size.x, InputTextCalcTextLenAndLineCount(buf_display, &buf_display_end) * g.FontSize); // We don't need width + else if (!is_displaying_hint && g.ActiveId == id) + buf_display_end = buf_display + state->CurLenA; + else if (!is_displaying_hint) + buf_display_end = buf_display + strlen(buf_display); + + if (is_multiline || (buf_display_end - buf_display) < buf_display_max_length) + { + ImU32 col = GetColorU32(is_displaying_hint ? ImGuiCol_TextDisabled : ImGuiCol_Text); + draw_window->DrawList->AddText(g.Font, g.FontSize, draw_pos, col, buf_display, buf_display_end, 0.0f, is_multiline ? NULL : &clip_rect); + } + } + + if (is_password && !is_displaying_hint) + PopFont(); + + if (is_multiline) + { + Dummy(ImVec2(text_size.x, text_size.y + style.FramePadding.y)); + EndChild(); + EndGroup(); + } + + // Log as text + if (g.LogEnabled && (!is_password || is_displaying_hint)) + { + LogSetNextTextDecoration("{", "}"); + LogRenderedText(&draw_pos, buf_display, buf_display_end); + } + + if (label_size.x > 0) + RenderText(ImVec2(frame_bb.Max.x + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x, frame_bb.Min.y + style.FramePadding.y), label); + + if (value_changed && !(flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_NoMarkEdited)) + MarkItemEdited(id); + + IMGUI_TEST_ENGINE_ITEM_INFO(id, label, g.LastItemData.StatusFlags); + if ((flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_EnterReturnsTrue) != 0) + return enter_pressed; + else + return value_changed; +} + +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Widgets: ColorEdit, ColorPicker, ColorButton, etc. +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// - ColorEdit3() +// - ColorEdit4() +// - ColorPicker3() +// - RenderColorRectWithAlphaCheckerboard() [Internal] +// - ColorPicker4() +// - ColorButton() +// - SetColorEditOptions() +// - ColorTooltip() [Internal] +// - ColorEditOptionsPopup() [Internal] +// - ColorPickerOptionsPopup() [Internal] +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +bool ImGui::ColorEdit3(const char* label, float col[3], ImGuiColorEditFlags flags) +{ + return ColorEdit4(label, col, flags | ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha); +} + +// Edit colors components (each component in 0.0f..1.0f range). +// See enum ImGuiColorEditFlags_ for available options. e.g. Only access 3 floats if ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha flag is set. +// With typical options: Left-click on color square to open color picker. Right-click to open option menu. CTRL-Click over input fields to edit them and TAB to go to next item. +bool ImGui::ColorEdit4(const char* label, float col[4], ImGuiColorEditFlags flags) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + if (window->SkipItems) + return false; + + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style; + const float square_sz = GetFrameHeight(); + const float w_full = CalcItemWidth(); + const float w_button = (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoSmallPreview) ? 0.0f : (square_sz + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x); + const float w_inputs = w_full - w_button; + const char* label_display_end = FindRenderedTextEnd(label); + g.NextItemData.ClearFlags(); + + BeginGroup(); + PushID(label); + + // If we're not showing any slider there's no point in doing any HSV conversions + const ImGuiColorEditFlags flags_untouched = flags; + if (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoInputs) + flags = (flags & (~ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayMask_)) | ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayRGB | ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoOptions; + + // Context menu: display and modify options (before defaults are applied) + if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoOptions)) + ColorEditOptionsPopup(col, flags); + + // Read stored options + if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayMask_)) + flags |= (g.ColorEditOptions & ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayMask_); + if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_DataTypeMask_)) + flags |= (g.ColorEditOptions & ImGuiColorEditFlags_DataTypeMask_); + if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_PickerMask_)) + flags |= (g.ColorEditOptions & ImGuiColorEditFlags_PickerMask_); + if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_InputMask_)) + flags |= (g.ColorEditOptions & ImGuiColorEditFlags_InputMask_); + flags |= (g.ColorEditOptions & ~(ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayMask_ | ImGuiColorEditFlags_DataTypeMask_ | ImGuiColorEditFlags_PickerMask_ | ImGuiColorEditFlags_InputMask_)); + IM_ASSERT(ImIsPowerOfTwo(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayMask_)); // Check that only 1 is selected + IM_ASSERT(ImIsPowerOfTwo(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_InputMask_)); // Check that only 1 is selected + + const bool alpha = (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha) == 0; + const bool hdr = (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_HDR) != 0; + const int components = alpha ? 4 : 3; + + // Convert to the formats we need + float f[4] = { col[0], col[1], col[2], alpha ? col[3] : 1.0f }; + if ((flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_InputHSV) && (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayRGB)) + ColorConvertHSVtoRGB(f[0], f[1], f[2], f[0], f[1], f[2]); + else if ((flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_InputRGB) && (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayHSV)) + { + // Hue is lost when converting from greyscale rgb (saturation=0). Restore it. + ColorConvertRGBtoHSV(f[0], f[1], f[2], f[0], f[1], f[2]); + if (memcmp(g.ColorEditLastColor, col, sizeof(float) * 3) == 0) + { + if (f[1] == 0) + f[0] = g.ColorEditLastHue; + if (f[2] == 0) + f[1] = g.ColorEditLastSat; + } + } + int i[4] = { IM_F32_TO_INT8_UNBOUND(f[0]), IM_F32_TO_INT8_UNBOUND(f[1]), IM_F32_TO_INT8_UNBOUND(f[2]), IM_F32_TO_INT8_UNBOUND(f[3]) }; + + bool value_changed = false; + bool value_changed_as_float = false; + + const ImVec2 pos = window->DC.CursorPos; + const float inputs_offset_x = (style.ColorButtonPosition == ImGuiDir_Left) ? w_button : 0.0f; + window->DC.CursorPos.x = pos.x + inputs_offset_x; + + if ((flags & (ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayRGB | ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayHSV)) != 0 && (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoInputs) == 0) + { + // RGB/HSV 0..255 Sliders + const float w_item_one = ImMax(1.0f, IM_FLOOR((w_inputs - (style.ItemInnerSpacing.x) * (components - 1)) / (float)components)); + const float w_item_last = ImMax(1.0f, IM_FLOOR(w_inputs - (w_item_one + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x) * (components - 1))); + + const bool hide_prefix = (w_item_one <= CalcTextSize((flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_Float) ? "M:0.000" : "M:000").x); + static const char* ids[4] = { "##X", "##Y", "##Z", "##W" }; + static const char* fmt_table_int[3][4] = + { + { "%3d", "%3d", "%3d", "%3d" }, // Short display + { "R:%3d", "G:%3d", "B:%3d", "A:%3d" }, // Long display for RGBA + { "H:%3d", "S:%3d", "V:%3d", "A:%3d" } // Long display for HSVA + }; + static const char* fmt_table_float[3][4] = + { + { "%0.3f", "%0.3f", "%0.3f", "%0.3f" }, // Short display + { "R:%0.3f", "G:%0.3f", "B:%0.3f", "A:%0.3f" }, // Long display for RGBA + { "H:%0.3f", "S:%0.3f", "V:%0.3f", "A:%0.3f" } // Long display for HSVA + }; + const int fmt_idx = hide_prefix ? 0 : (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayHSV) ? 2 : 1; + + for (int n = 0; n < components; n++) + { + if (n > 0) + SameLine(0, style.ItemInnerSpacing.x); + SetNextItemWidth((n + 1 < components) ? w_item_one : w_item_last); + + // FIXME: When ImGuiColorEditFlags_HDR flag is passed HS values snap in weird ways when SV values go below 0. + if (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_Float) + { + value_changed |= DragFloat(ids[n], &f[n], 1.0f / 255.0f, 0.0f, hdr ? 0.0f : 1.0f, fmt_table_float[fmt_idx][n]); + value_changed_as_float |= value_changed; + } + else + { + value_changed |= DragInt(ids[n], &i[n], 1.0f, 0, hdr ? 0 : 255, fmt_table_int[fmt_idx][n]); + } + if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoOptions)) + OpenPopupOnItemClick("context"); + } + } + else if ((flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayHex) != 0 && (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoInputs) == 0) + { + // RGB Hexadecimal Input + char buf[64]; + if (alpha) + ImFormatString(buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf), "#%02X%02X%02X%02X", ImClamp(i[0], 0, 255), ImClamp(i[1], 0, 255), ImClamp(i[2], 0, 255), ImClamp(i[3], 0, 255)); + else + ImFormatString(buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf), "#%02X%02X%02X", ImClamp(i[0], 0, 255), ImClamp(i[1], 0, 255), ImClamp(i[2], 0, 255)); + SetNextItemWidth(w_inputs); + if (InputText("##Text", buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf), ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsHexadecimal | ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsUppercase)) + { + value_changed = true; + char* p = buf; + while (*p == '#' || ImCharIsBlankA(*p)) + p++; + i[0] = i[1] = i[2] = 0; + i[3] = 0xFF; // alpha default to 255 is not parsed by scanf (e.g. inputting #FFFFFF omitting alpha) + int r; + if (alpha) + r = sscanf(p, "%02X%02X%02X%02X", (unsigned int*)&i[0], (unsigned int*)&i[1], (unsigned int*)&i[2], (unsigned int*)&i[3]); // Treat at unsigned (%X is unsigned) + else + r = sscanf(p, "%02X%02X%02X", (unsigned int*)&i[0], (unsigned int*)&i[1], (unsigned int*)&i[2]); + IM_UNUSED(r); // Fixes C6031: Return value ignored: 'sscanf'. + } + if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoOptions)) + OpenPopupOnItemClick("context"); + } + + ImGuiWindow* picker_active_window = NULL; + if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoSmallPreview)) + { + const float button_offset_x = ((flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoInputs) || (style.ColorButtonPosition == ImGuiDir_Left)) ? 0.0f : w_inputs + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x; + window->DC.CursorPos = ImVec2(pos.x + button_offset_x, pos.y); + + const ImVec4 col_v4(col[0], col[1], col[2], alpha ? col[3] : 1.0f); + if (ColorButton("##ColorButton", col_v4, flags)) + { + if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoPicker)) + { + // Store current color and open a picker + g.ColorPickerRef = col_v4; + OpenPopup("picker"); + SetNextWindowPos(g.LastItemData.Rect.GetBL() + ImVec2(-1, style.ItemSpacing.y)); + } + } + if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoOptions)) + OpenPopupOnItemClick("context"); + + if (BeginPopup("picker")) + { + picker_active_window = g.CurrentWindow; + if (label != label_display_end) + { + TextEx(label, label_display_end); + Spacing(); + } + ImGuiColorEditFlags picker_flags_to_forward = ImGuiColorEditFlags_DataTypeMask_ | ImGuiColorEditFlags_PickerMask_ | ImGuiColorEditFlags_InputMask_ | ImGuiColorEditFlags_HDR | ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha | ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaBar; + ImGuiColorEditFlags picker_flags = (flags_untouched & picker_flags_to_forward) | ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayMask_ | ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoLabel | ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaPreviewHalf; + SetNextItemWidth(square_sz * 12.0f); // Use 256 + bar sizes? + value_changed |= ColorPicker4("##picker", col, picker_flags, &g.ColorPickerRef.x); + EndPopup(); + } + } + + if (label != label_display_end && !(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoLabel)) + { + const float text_offset_x = (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoInputs) ? w_button : w_full + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x; + window->DC.CursorPos = ImVec2(pos.x + text_offset_x, pos.y + style.FramePadding.y); + TextEx(label, label_display_end); + } + + // Convert back + if (value_changed && picker_active_window == NULL) + { + if (!value_changed_as_float) + for (int n = 0; n < 4; n++) + f[n] = i[n] / 255.0f; + if ((flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayHSV) && (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_InputRGB)) + { + g.ColorEditLastHue = f[0]; + g.ColorEditLastSat = f[1]; + ColorConvertHSVtoRGB(f[0], f[1], f[2], f[0], f[1], f[2]); + memcpy(g.ColorEditLastColor, f, sizeof(float) * 3); + } + if ((flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayRGB) && (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_InputHSV)) + ColorConvertRGBtoHSV(f[0], f[1], f[2], f[0], f[1], f[2]); + + col[0] = f[0]; + col[1] = f[1]; + col[2] = f[2]; + if (alpha) + col[3] = f[3]; + } + + PopID(); + EndGroup(); + + // Drag and Drop Target + // NB: The flag test is merely an optional micro-optimization, BeginDragDropTarget() does the same test. + if ((g.LastItemData.StatusFlags & ImGuiItemStatusFlags_HoveredRect) && !(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoDragDrop) && BeginDragDropTarget()) + { + bool accepted_drag_drop = false; + if (const ImGuiPayload* payload = AcceptDragDropPayload(IMGUI_PAYLOAD_TYPE_COLOR_3F)) + { + memcpy((float*)col, payload->Data, sizeof(float) * 3); // Preserve alpha if any //-V512 + value_changed = accepted_drag_drop = true; + } + if (const ImGuiPayload* payload = AcceptDragDropPayload(IMGUI_PAYLOAD_TYPE_COLOR_4F)) + { + memcpy((float*)col, payload->Data, sizeof(float) * components); + value_changed = accepted_drag_drop = true; + } + + // Drag-drop payloads are always RGB + if (accepted_drag_drop && (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_InputHSV)) + ColorConvertRGBtoHSV(col[0], col[1], col[2], col[0], col[1], col[2]); + EndDragDropTarget(); + } + + // When picker is being actively used, use its active id so IsItemActive() will function on ColorEdit4(). + if (picker_active_window && g.ActiveId != 0 && g.ActiveIdWindow == picker_active_window) + g.LastItemData.ID = g.ActiveId; + + if (value_changed) + MarkItemEdited(g.LastItemData.ID); + + return value_changed; +} + +bool ImGui::ColorPicker3(const char* label, float col[3], ImGuiColorEditFlags flags) +{ + float col4[4] = { col[0], col[1], col[2], 1.0f }; + if (!ColorPicker4(label, col4, flags | ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha)) + return false; + col[0] = col4[0]; col[1] = col4[1]; col[2] = col4[2]; + return true; +} + +// Helper for ColorPicker4() +static void RenderArrowsForVerticalBar(ImDrawList* draw_list, ImVec2 pos, ImVec2 half_sz, float bar_w, float alpha) +{ + ImU32 alpha8 = IM_F32_TO_INT8_SAT(alpha); + ImGui::RenderArrowPointingAt(draw_list, ImVec2(pos.x + half_sz.x + 1, pos.y), ImVec2(half_sz.x + 2, half_sz.y + 1), ImGuiDir_Right, IM_COL32(0,0,0,alpha8)); + ImGui::RenderArrowPointingAt(draw_list, ImVec2(pos.x + half_sz.x, pos.y), half_sz, ImGuiDir_Right, IM_COL32(255,255,255,alpha8)); + ImGui::RenderArrowPointingAt(draw_list, ImVec2(pos.x + bar_w - half_sz.x - 1, pos.y), ImVec2(half_sz.x + 2, half_sz.y + 1), ImGuiDir_Left, IM_COL32(0,0,0,alpha8)); + ImGui::RenderArrowPointingAt(draw_list, ImVec2(pos.x + bar_w - half_sz.x, pos.y), half_sz, ImGuiDir_Left, IM_COL32(255,255,255,alpha8)); +} + +// Note: ColorPicker4() only accesses 3 floats if ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha flag is set. +// (In C++ the 'float col[4]' notation for a function argument is equivalent to 'float* col', we only specify a size to facilitate understanding of the code.) +// FIXME: we adjust the big color square height based on item width, which may cause a flickering feedback loop (if automatic height makes a vertical scrollbar appears, affecting automatic width..) +// FIXME: this is trying to be aware of style.Alpha but not fully correct. Also, the color wheel will have overlapping glitches with (style.Alpha < 1.0) +bool ImGui::ColorPicker4(const char* label, float col[4], ImGuiColorEditFlags flags, const float* ref_col) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + if (window->SkipItems) + return false; + + ImDrawList* draw_list = window->DrawList; + ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style; + ImGuiIO& io = g.IO; + + const float width = CalcItemWidth(); + g.NextItemData.ClearFlags(); + + PushID(label); + BeginGroup(); + + if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoSidePreview)) + flags |= ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoSmallPreview; + + // Context menu: display and store options. + if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoOptions)) + ColorPickerOptionsPopup(col, flags); + + // Read stored options + if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_PickerMask_)) + flags |= ((g.ColorEditOptions & ImGuiColorEditFlags_PickerMask_) ? g.ColorEditOptions : ImGuiColorEditFlags_DefaultOptions_) & ImGuiColorEditFlags_PickerMask_; + if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_InputMask_)) + flags |= ((g.ColorEditOptions & ImGuiColorEditFlags_InputMask_) ? g.ColorEditOptions : ImGuiColorEditFlags_DefaultOptions_) & ImGuiColorEditFlags_InputMask_; + IM_ASSERT(ImIsPowerOfTwo(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_PickerMask_)); // Check that only 1 is selected + IM_ASSERT(ImIsPowerOfTwo(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_InputMask_)); // Check that only 1 is selected + if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoOptions)) + flags |= (g.ColorEditOptions & ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaBar); + + // Setup + int components = (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha) ? 3 : 4; + bool alpha_bar = (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaBar) && !(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha); + ImVec2 picker_pos = window->DC.CursorPos; + float square_sz = GetFrameHeight(); + float bars_width = square_sz; // Arbitrary smallish width of Hue/Alpha picking bars + float sv_picker_size = ImMax(bars_width * 1, width - (alpha_bar ? 2 : 1) * (bars_width + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x)); // Saturation/Value picking box + float bar0_pos_x = picker_pos.x + sv_picker_size + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x; + float bar1_pos_x = bar0_pos_x + bars_width + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x; + float bars_triangles_half_sz = IM_FLOOR(bars_width * 0.20f); + + float backup_initial_col[4]; + memcpy(backup_initial_col, col, components * sizeof(float)); + + float wheel_thickness = sv_picker_size * 0.08f; + float wheel_r_outer = sv_picker_size * 0.50f; + float wheel_r_inner = wheel_r_outer - wheel_thickness; + ImVec2 wheel_center(picker_pos.x + (sv_picker_size + bars_width)*0.5f, picker_pos.y + sv_picker_size * 0.5f); + + // Note: the triangle is displayed rotated with triangle_pa pointing to Hue, but most coordinates stays unrotated for logic. + float triangle_r = wheel_r_inner - (int)(sv_picker_size * 0.027f); + ImVec2 triangle_pa = ImVec2(triangle_r, 0.0f); // Hue point. + ImVec2 triangle_pb = ImVec2(triangle_r * -0.5f, triangle_r * -0.866025f); // Black point. + ImVec2 triangle_pc = ImVec2(triangle_r * -0.5f, triangle_r * +0.866025f); // White point. + + float H = col[0], S = col[1], V = col[2]; + float R = col[0], G = col[1], B = col[2]; + if (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_InputRGB) + { + // Hue is lost when converting from greyscale rgb (saturation=0). Restore it. + ColorConvertRGBtoHSV(R, G, B, H, S, V); + if (memcmp(g.ColorEditLastColor, col, sizeof(float) * 3) == 0) + { + if (S == 0) + H = g.ColorEditLastHue; + if (V == 0) + S = g.ColorEditLastSat; + } + } + else if (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_InputHSV) + { + ColorConvertHSVtoRGB(H, S, V, R, G, B); + } + + bool value_changed = false, value_changed_h = false, value_changed_sv = false; + + PushItemFlag(ImGuiItemFlags_NoNav, true); + if (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_PickerHueWheel) + { + // Hue wheel + SV triangle logic + InvisibleButton("hsv", ImVec2(sv_picker_size + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x + bars_width, sv_picker_size)); + if (IsItemActive()) + { + ImVec2 initial_off = g.IO.MouseClickedPos[0] - wheel_center; + ImVec2 current_off = g.IO.MousePos - wheel_center; + float initial_dist2 = ImLengthSqr(initial_off); + if (initial_dist2 >= (wheel_r_inner - 1) * (wheel_r_inner - 1) && initial_dist2 <= (wheel_r_outer + 1) * (wheel_r_outer + 1)) + { + // Interactive with Hue wheel + H = ImAtan2(current_off.y, current_off.x) / IM_PI * 0.5f; + if (H < 0.0f) + H += 1.0f; + value_changed = value_changed_h = true; + } + float cos_hue_angle = ImCos(-H * 2.0f * IM_PI); + float sin_hue_angle = ImSin(-H * 2.0f * IM_PI); + if (ImTriangleContainsPoint(triangle_pa, triangle_pb, triangle_pc, ImRotate(initial_off, cos_hue_angle, sin_hue_angle))) + { + // Interacting with SV triangle + ImVec2 current_off_unrotated = ImRotate(current_off, cos_hue_angle, sin_hue_angle); + if (!ImTriangleContainsPoint(triangle_pa, triangle_pb, triangle_pc, current_off_unrotated)) + current_off_unrotated = ImTriangleClosestPoint(triangle_pa, triangle_pb, triangle_pc, current_off_unrotated); + float uu, vv, ww; + ImTriangleBarycentricCoords(triangle_pa, triangle_pb, triangle_pc, current_off_unrotated, uu, vv, ww); + V = ImClamp(1.0f - vv, 0.0001f, 1.0f); + S = ImClamp(uu / V, 0.0001f, 1.0f); + value_changed = value_changed_sv = true; + } + } + if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoOptions)) + OpenPopupOnItemClick("context"); + } + else if (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_PickerHueBar) + { + // SV rectangle logic + InvisibleButton("sv", ImVec2(sv_picker_size, sv_picker_size)); + if (IsItemActive()) + { + S = ImSaturate((io.MousePos.x - picker_pos.x) / (sv_picker_size - 1)); + V = 1.0f - ImSaturate((io.MousePos.y - picker_pos.y) / (sv_picker_size - 1)); + value_changed = value_changed_sv = true; + } + if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoOptions)) + OpenPopupOnItemClick("context"); + + // Hue bar logic + SetCursorScreenPos(ImVec2(bar0_pos_x, picker_pos.y)); + InvisibleButton("hue", ImVec2(bars_width, sv_picker_size)); + if (IsItemActive()) + { + H = ImSaturate((io.MousePos.y - picker_pos.y) / (sv_picker_size - 1)); + value_changed = value_changed_h = true; + } + } + + // Alpha bar logic + if (alpha_bar) + { + SetCursorScreenPos(ImVec2(bar1_pos_x, picker_pos.y)); + InvisibleButton("alpha", ImVec2(bars_width, sv_picker_size)); + if (IsItemActive()) + { + col[3] = 1.0f - ImSaturate((io.MousePos.y - picker_pos.y) / (sv_picker_size - 1)); + value_changed = true; + } + } + PopItemFlag(); // ImGuiItemFlags_NoNav + + if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoSidePreview)) + { + SameLine(0, style.ItemInnerSpacing.x); + BeginGroup(); + } + + if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoLabel)) + { + const char* label_display_end = FindRenderedTextEnd(label); + if (label != label_display_end) + { + if ((flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoSidePreview)) + SameLine(0, style.ItemInnerSpacing.x); + TextEx(label, label_display_end); + } + } + + if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoSidePreview)) + { + PushItemFlag(ImGuiItemFlags_NoNavDefaultFocus, true); + ImVec4 col_v4(col[0], col[1], col[2], (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha) ? 1.0f : col[3]); + if ((flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoLabel)) + Text("Current"); + + ImGuiColorEditFlags sub_flags_to_forward = ImGuiColorEditFlags_InputMask_ | ImGuiColorEditFlags_HDR | ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaPreview | ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaPreviewHalf | ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoTooltip; + ColorButton("##current", col_v4, (flags & sub_flags_to_forward), ImVec2(square_sz * 3, square_sz * 2)); + if (ref_col != NULL) + { + Text("Original"); + ImVec4 ref_col_v4(ref_col[0], ref_col[1], ref_col[2], (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha) ? 1.0f : ref_col[3]); + if (ColorButton("##original", ref_col_v4, (flags & sub_flags_to_forward), ImVec2(square_sz * 3, square_sz * 2))) + { + memcpy(col, ref_col, components * sizeof(float)); + value_changed = true; + } + } + PopItemFlag(); + EndGroup(); + } + + // Convert back color to RGB + if (value_changed_h || value_changed_sv) + { + if (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_InputRGB) + { + ColorConvertHSVtoRGB(H >= 1.0f ? H - 10 * 1e-6f : H, S > 0.0f ? S : 10 * 1e-6f, V > 0.0f ? V : 1e-6f, col[0], col[1], col[2]); + g.ColorEditLastHue = H; + g.ColorEditLastSat = S; + memcpy(g.ColorEditLastColor, col, sizeof(float) * 3); + } + else if (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_InputHSV) + { + col[0] = H; + col[1] = S; + col[2] = V; + } + } + + // R,G,B and H,S,V slider color editor + bool value_changed_fix_hue_wrap = false; + if ((flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoInputs) == 0) + { + PushItemWidth((alpha_bar ? bar1_pos_x : bar0_pos_x) + bars_width - picker_pos.x); + ImGuiColorEditFlags sub_flags_to_forward = ImGuiColorEditFlags_DataTypeMask_ | ImGuiColorEditFlags_InputMask_ | ImGuiColorEditFlags_HDR | ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha | ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoOptions | ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoSmallPreview | ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaPreview | ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaPreviewHalf; + ImGuiColorEditFlags sub_flags = (flags & sub_flags_to_forward) | ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoPicker; + if (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayRGB || (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayMask_) == 0) + if (ColorEdit4("##rgb", col, sub_flags | ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayRGB)) + { + // FIXME: Hackily differentiating using the DragInt (ActiveId != 0 && !ActiveIdAllowOverlap) vs. using the InputText or DropTarget. + // For the later we don't want to run the hue-wrap canceling code. If you are well versed in HSV picker please provide your input! (See #2050) + value_changed_fix_hue_wrap = (g.ActiveId != 0 && !g.ActiveIdAllowOverlap); + value_changed = true; + } + if (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayHSV || (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayMask_) == 0) + value_changed |= ColorEdit4("##hsv", col, sub_flags | ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayHSV); + if (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayHex || (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayMask_) == 0) + value_changed |= ColorEdit4("##hex", col, sub_flags | ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayHex); + PopItemWidth(); + } + + // Try to cancel hue wrap (after ColorEdit4 call), if any + if (value_changed_fix_hue_wrap && (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_InputRGB)) + { + float new_H, new_S, new_V; + ColorConvertRGBtoHSV(col[0], col[1], col[2], new_H, new_S, new_V); + if (new_H <= 0 && H > 0) + { + if (new_V <= 0 && V != new_V) + ColorConvertHSVtoRGB(H, S, new_V <= 0 ? V * 0.5f : new_V, col[0], col[1], col[2]); + else if (new_S <= 0) + ColorConvertHSVtoRGB(H, new_S <= 0 ? S * 0.5f : new_S, new_V, col[0], col[1], col[2]); + } + } + + if (value_changed) + { + if (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_InputRGB) + { + R = col[0]; + G = col[1]; + B = col[2]; + ColorConvertRGBtoHSV(R, G, B, H, S, V); + if (memcmp(g.ColorEditLastColor, col, sizeof(float) * 3) == 0) // Fix local Hue as display below will use it immediately. + { + if (S == 0) + H = g.ColorEditLastHue; + if (V == 0) + S = g.ColorEditLastSat; + } + } + else if (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_InputHSV) + { + H = col[0]; + S = col[1]; + V = col[2]; + ColorConvertHSVtoRGB(H, S, V, R, G, B); + } + } + + const int style_alpha8 = IM_F32_TO_INT8_SAT(style.Alpha); + const ImU32 col_black = IM_COL32(0,0,0,style_alpha8); + const ImU32 col_white = IM_COL32(255,255,255,style_alpha8); + const ImU32 col_midgrey = IM_COL32(128,128,128,style_alpha8); + const ImU32 col_hues[6 + 1] = { IM_COL32(255,0,0,style_alpha8), IM_COL32(255,255,0,style_alpha8), IM_COL32(0,255,0,style_alpha8), IM_COL32(0,255,255,style_alpha8), IM_COL32(0,0,255,style_alpha8), IM_COL32(255,0,255,style_alpha8), IM_COL32(255,0,0,style_alpha8) }; + + ImVec4 hue_color_f(1, 1, 1, style.Alpha); ColorConvertHSVtoRGB(H, 1, 1, hue_color_f.x, hue_color_f.y, hue_color_f.z); + ImU32 hue_color32 = ColorConvertFloat4ToU32(hue_color_f); + ImU32 user_col32_striped_of_alpha = ColorConvertFloat4ToU32(ImVec4(R, G, B, style.Alpha)); // Important: this is still including the main rendering/style alpha!! + + ImVec2 sv_cursor_pos; + + if (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_PickerHueWheel) + { + // Render Hue Wheel + const float aeps = 0.5f / wheel_r_outer; // Half a pixel arc length in radians (2pi cancels out). + const int segment_per_arc = ImMax(4, (int)wheel_r_outer / 12); + for (int n = 0; n < 6; n++) + { + const float a0 = (n) /6.0f * 2.0f * IM_PI - aeps; + const float a1 = (n+1.0f)/6.0f * 2.0f * IM_PI + aeps; + const int vert_start_idx = draw_list->VtxBuffer.Size; + draw_list->PathArcTo(wheel_center, (wheel_r_inner + wheel_r_outer)*0.5f, a0, a1, segment_per_arc); + draw_list->PathStroke(col_white, 0, wheel_thickness); + const int vert_end_idx = draw_list->VtxBuffer.Size; + + // Paint colors over existing vertices + ImVec2 gradient_p0(wheel_center.x + ImCos(a0) * wheel_r_inner, wheel_center.y + ImSin(a0) * wheel_r_inner); + ImVec2 gradient_p1(wheel_center.x + ImCos(a1) * wheel_r_inner, wheel_center.y + ImSin(a1) * wheel_r_inner); + ShadeVertsLinearColorGradientKeepAlpha(draw_list, vert_start_idx, vert_end_idx, gradient_p0, gradient_p1, col_hues[n], col_hues[n + 1]); + } + + // Render Cursor + preview on Hue Wheel + float cos_hue_angle = ImCos(H * 2.0f * IM_PI); + float sin_hue_angle = ImSin(H * 2.0f * IM_PI); + ImVec2 hue_cursor_pos(wheel_center.x + cos_hue_angle * (wheel_r_inner + wheel_r_outer) * 0.5f, wheel_center.y + sin_hue_angle * (wheel_r_inner + wheel_r_outer) * 0.5f); + float hue_cursor_rad = value_changed_h ? wheel_thickness * 0.65f : wheel_thickness * 0.55f; + int hue_cursor_segments = ImClamp((int)(hue_cursor_rad / 1.4f), 9, 32); + draw_list->AddCircleFilled(hue_cursor_pos, hue_cursor_rad, hue_color32, hue_cursor_segments); + draw_list->AddCircle(hue_cursor_pos, hue_cursor_rad + 1, col_midgrey, hue_cursor_segments); + draw_list->AddCircle(hue_cursor_pos, hue_cursor_rad, col_white, hue_cursor_segments); + + // Render SV triangle (rotated according to hue) + ImVec2 tra = wheel_center + ImRotate(triangle_pa, cos_hue_angle, sin_hue_angle); + ImVec2 trb = wheel_center + ImRotate(triangle_pb, cos_hue_angle, sin_hue_angle); + ImVec2 trc = wheel_center + ImRotate(triangle_pc, cos_hue_angle, sin_hue_angle); + ImVec2 uv_white = GetFontTexUvWhitePixel(); + draw_list->PrimReserve(6, 6); + draw_list->PrimVtx(tra, uv_white, hue_color32); + draw_list->PrimVtx(trb, uv_white, hue_color32); + draw_list->PrimVtx(trc, uv_white, col_white); + draw_list->PrimVtx(tra, uv_white, 0); + draw_list->PrimVtx(trb, uv_white, col_black); + draw_list->PrimVtx(trc, uv_white, 0); + draw_list->AddTriangle(tra, trb, trc, col_midgrey, 1.5f); + sv_cursor_pos = ImLerp(ImLerp(trc, tra, ImSaturate(S)), trb, ImSaturate(1 - V)); + } + else if (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_PickerHueBar) + { + // Render SV Square + draw_list->AddRectFilledMultiColor(picker_pos, picker_pos + ImVec2(sv_picker_size, sv_picker_size), col_white, hue_color32, hue_color32, col_white); + draw_list->AddRectFilledMultiColor(picker_pos, picker_pos + ImVec2(sv_picker_size, sv_picker_size), 0, 0, col_black, col_black); + RenderFrameBorder(picker_pos, picker_pos + ImVec2(sv_picker_size, sv_picker_size), 0.0f); + sv_cursor_pos.x = ImClamp(IM_ROUND(picker_pos.x + ImSaturate(S) * sv_picker_size), picker_pos.x + 2, picker_pos.x + sv_picker_size - 2); // Sneakily prevent the circle to stick out too much + sv_cursor_pos.y = ImClamp(IM_ROUND(picker_pos.y + ImSaturate(1 - V) * sv_picker_size), picker_pos.y + 2, picker_pos.y + sv_picker_size - 2); + + // Render Hue Bar + for (int i = 0; i < 6; ++i) + draw_list->AddRectFilledMultiColor(ImVec2(bar0_pos_x, picker_pos.y + i * (sv_picker_size / 6)), ImVec2(bar0_pos_x + bars_width, picker_pos.y + (i + 1) * (sv_picker_size / 6)), col_hues[i], col_hues[i], col_hues[i + 1], col_hues[i + 1]); + float bar0_line_y = IM_ROUND(picker_pos.y + H * sv_picker_size); + RenderFrameBorder(ImVec2(bar0_pos_x, picker_pos.y), ImVec2(bar0_pos_x + bars_width, picker_pos.y + sv_picker_size), 0.0f); + RenderArrowsForVerticalBar(draw_list, ImVec2(bar0_pos_x - 1, bar0_line_y), ImVec2(bars_triangles_half_sz + 1, bars_triangles_half_sz), bars_width + 2.0f, style.Alpha); + } + + // Render cursor/preview circle (clamp S/V within 0..1 range because floating points colors may lead HSV values to be out of range) + float sv_cursor_rad = value_changed_sv ? 10.0f : 6.0f; + draw_list->AddCircleFilled(sv_cursor_pos, sv_cursor_rad, user_col32_striped_of_alpha, 12); + draw_list->AddCircle(sv_cursor_pos, sv_cursor_rad + 1, col_midgrey, 12); + draw_list->AddCircle(sv_cursor_pos, sv_cursor_rad, col_white, 12); + + // Render alpha bar + if (alpha_bar) + { + float alpha = ImSaturate(col[3]); + ImRect bar1_bb(bar1_pos_x, picker_pos.y, bar1_pos_x + bars_width, picker_pos.y + sv_picker_size); + RenderColorRectWithAlphaCheckerboard(draw_list, bar1_bb.Min, bar1_bb.Max, 0, bar1_bb.GetWidth() / 2.0f, ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f)); + draw_list->AddRectFilledMultiColor(bar1_bb.Min, bar1_bb.Max, user_col32_striped_of_alpha, user_col32_striped_of_alpha, user_col32_striped_of_alpha & ~IM_COL32_A_MASK, user_col32_striped_of_alpha & ~IM_COL32_A_MASK); + float bar1_line_y = IM_ROUND(picker_pos.y + (1.0f - alpha) * sv_picker_size); + RenderFrameBorder(bar1_bb.Min, bar1_bb.Max, 0.0f); + RenderArrowsForVerticalBar(draw_list, ImVec2(bar1_pos_x - 1, bar1_line_y), ImVec2(bars_triangles_half_sz + 1, bars_triangles_half_sz), bars_width + 2.0f, style.Alpha); + } + + EndGroup(); + + if (value_changed && memcmp(backup_initial_col, col, components * sizeof(float)) == 0) + value_changed = false; + if (value_changed) + MarkItemEdited(g.LastItemData.ID); + + PopID(); + + return value_changed; +} + +// A little color square. Return true when clicked. +// FIXME: May want to display/ignore the alpha component in the color display? Yet show it in the tooltip. +// 'desc_id' is not called 'label' because we don't display it next to the button, but only in the tooltip. +// Note that 'col' may be encoded in HSV if ImGuiColorEditFlags_InputHSV is set. +bool ImGui::ColorButton(const char* desc_id, const ImVec4& col, ImGuiColorEditFlags flags, ImVec2 size) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + if (window->SkipItems) + return false; + + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + const ImGuiID id = window->GetID(desc_id); + float default_size = GetFrameHeight(); + if (size.x == 0.0f) + size.x = default_size; + if (size.y == 0.0f) + size.y = default_size; + const ImRect bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + size); + ItemSize(bb, (size.y >= default_size) ? g.Style.FramePadding.y : 0.0f); + if (!ItemAdd(bb, id)) + return false; + + bool hovered, held; + bool pressed = ButtonBehavior(bb, id, &hovered, &held); + + if (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha) + flags &= ~(ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaPreview | ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaPreviewHalf); + + ImVec4 col_rgb = col; + if (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_InputHSV) + ColorConvertHSVtoRGB(col_rgb.x, col_rgb.y, col_rgb.z, col_rgb.x, col_rgb.y, col_rgb.z); + + ImVec4 col_rgb_without_alpha(col_rgb.x, col_rgb.y, col_rgb.z, 1.0f); + float grid_step = ImMin(size.x, size.y) / 2.99f; + float rounding = ImMin(g.Style.FrameRounding, grid_step * 0.5f); + ImRect bb_inner = bb; + float off = 0.0f; + if ((flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoBorder) == 0) + { + off = -0.75f; // The border (using Col_FrameBg) tends to look off when color is near-opaque and rounding is enabled. This offset seemed like a good middle ground to reduce those artifacts. + bb_inner.Expand(off); + } + if ((flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaPreviewHalf) && col_rgb.w < 1.0f) + { + float mid_x = IM_ROUND((bb_inner.Min.x + bb_inner.Max.x) * 0.5f); + RenderColorRectWithAlphaCheckerboard(window->DrawList, ImVec2(bb_inner.Min.x + grid_step, bb_inner.Min.y), bb_inner.Max, GetColorU32(col_rgb), grid_step, ImVec2(-grid_step + off, off), rounding, ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersRight); + window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(bb_inner.Min, ImVec2(mid_x, bb_inner.Max.y), GetColorU32(col_rgb_without_alpha), rounding, ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersLeft); + } + else + { + // Because GetColorU32() multiplies by the global style Alpha and we don't want to display a checkerboard if the source code had no alpha + ImVec4 col_source = (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaPreview) ? col_rgb : col_rgb_without_alpha; + if (col_source.w < 1.0f) + RenderColorRectWithAlphaCheckerboard(window->DrawList, bb_inner.Min, bb_inner.Max, GetColorU32(col_source), grid_step, ImVec2(off, off), rounding); + else + window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(bb_inner.Min, bb_inner.Max, GetColorU32(col_source), rounding); + } + RenderNavHighlight(bb, id); + if ((flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoBorder) == 0) + { + if (g.Style.FrameBorderSize > 0.0f) + RenderFrameBorder(bb.Min, bb.Max, rounding); + else + window->DrawList->AddRect(bb.Min, bb.Max, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_FrameBg), rounding); // Color button are often in need of some sort of border + } + + // Drag and Drop Source + // NB: The ActiveId test is merely an optional micro-optimization, BeginDragDropSource() does the same test. + if (g.ActiveId == id && !(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoDragDrop) && BeginDragDropSource()) + { + if (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha) + SetDragDropPayload(IMGUI_PAYLOAD_TYPE_COLOR_3F, &col_rgb, sizeof(float) * 3, ImGuiCond_Once); + else + SetDragDropPayload(IMGUI_PAYLOAD_TYPE_COLOR_4F, &col_rgb, sizeof(float) * 4, ImGuiCond_Once); + ColorButton(desc_id, col, flags); + SameLine(); + TextEx("Color"); + EndDragDropSource(); + } + + // Tooltip + if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoTooltip) && hovered) + ColorTooltip(desc_id, &col.x, flags & (ImGuiColorEditFlags_InputMask_ | ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha | ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaPreview | ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaPreviewHalf)); + + return pressed; +} + +// Initialize/override default color options +void ImGui::SetColorEditOptions(ImGuiColorEditFlags flags) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + if ((flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayMask_) == 0) + flags |= ImGuiColorEditFlags_DefaultOptions_ & ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayMask_; + if ((flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_DataTypeMask_) == 0) + flags |= ImGuiColorEditFlags_DefaultOptions_ & ImGuiColorEditFlags_DataTypeMask_; + if ((flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_PickerMask_) == 0) + flags |= ImGuiColorEditFlags_DefaultOptions_ & ImGuiColorEditFlags_PickerMask_; + if ((flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_InputMask_) == 0) + flags |= ImGuiColorEditFlags_DefaultOptions_ & ImGuiColorEditFlags_InputMask_; + IM_ASSERT(ImIsPowerOfTwo(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayMask_)); // Check only 1 option is selected + IM_ASSERT(ImIsPowerOfTwo(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_DataTypeMask_)); // Check only 1 option is selected + IM_ASSERT(ImIsPowerOfTwo(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_PickerMask_)); // Check only 1 option is selected + IM_ASSERT(ImIsPowerOfTwo(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_InputMask_)); // Check only 1 option is selected + g.ColorEditOptions = flags; +} + +// Note: only access 3 floats if ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha flag is set. +void ImGui::ColorTooltip(const char* text, const float* col, ImGuiColorEditFlags flags) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + + BeginTooltipEx(0, ImGuiTooltipFlags_OverridePreviousTooltip); + const char* text_end = text ? FindRenderedTextEnd(text, NULL) : text; + if (text_end > text) + { + TextEx(text, text_end); + Separator(); + } + + ImVec2 sz(g.FontSize * 3 + g.Style.FramePadding.y * 2, g.FontSize * 3 + g.Style.FramePadding.y * 2); + ImVec4 cf(col[0], col[1], col[2], (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha) ? 1.0f : col[3]); + int cr = IM_F32_TO_INT8_SAT(col[0]), cg = IM_F32_TO_INT8_SAT(col[1]), cb = IM_F32_TO_INT8_SAT(col[2]), ca = (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha) ? 255 : IM_F32_TO_INT8_SAT(col[3]); + ColorButton("##preview", cf, (flags & (ImGuiColorEditFlags_InputMask_ | ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha | ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaPreview | ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaPreviewHalf)) | ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoTooltip, sz); + SameLine(); + if ((flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_InputRGB) || !(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_InputMask_)) + { + if (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha) + Text("#%02X%02X%02X\nR: %d, G: %d, B: %d\n(%.3f, %.3f, %.3f)", cr, cg, cb, cr, cg, cb, col[0], col[1], col[2]); + else + Text("#%02X%02X%02X%02X\nR:%d, G:%d, B:%d, A:%d\n(%.3f, %.3f, %.3f, %.3f)", cr, cg, cb, ca, cr, cg, cb, ca, col[0], col[1], col[2], col[3]); + } + else if (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_InputHSV) + { + if (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha) + Text("H: %.3f, S: %.3f, V: %.3f", col[0], col[1], col[2]); + else + Text("H: %.3f, S: %.3f, V: %.3f, A: %.3f", col[0], col[1], col[2], col[3]); + } + EndTooltip(); +} + +void ImGui::ColorEditOptionsPopup(const float* col, ImGuiColorEditFlags flags) +{ + bool allow_opt_inputs = !(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayMask_); + bool allow_opt_datatype = !(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_DataTypeMask_); + if ((!allow_opt_inputs && !allow_opt_datatype) || !BeginPopup("context")) + return; + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiColorEditFlags opts = g.ColorEditOptions; + if (allow_opt_inputs) + { + if (RadioButton("RGB", (opts & ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayRGB) != 0)) opts = (opts & ~ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayMask_) | ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayRGB; + if (RadioButton("HSV", (opts & ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayHSV) != 0)) opts = (opts & ~ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayMask_) | ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayHSV; + if (RadioButton("Hex", (opts & ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayHex) != 0)) opts = (opts & ~ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayMask_) | ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayHex; + } + if (allow_opt_datatype) + { + if (allow_opt_inputs) Separator(); + if (RadioButton("0..255", (opts & ImGuiColorEditFlags_Uint8) != 0)) opts = (opts & ~ImGuiColorEditFlags_DataTypeMask_) | ImGuiColorEditFlags_Uint8; + if (RadioButton("0.00..1.00", (opts & ImGuiColorEditFlags_Float) != 0)) opts = (opts & ~ImGuiColorEditFlags_DataTypeMask_) | ImGuiColorEditFlags_Float; + } + + if (allow_opt_inputs || allow_opt_datatype) + Separator(); + if (Button("Copy as..", ImVec2(-1, 0))) + OpenPopup("Copy"); + if (BeginPopup("Copy")) + { + int cr = IM_F32_TO_INT8_SAT(col[0]), cg = IM_F32_TO_INT8_SAT(col[1]), cb = IM_F32_TO_INT8_SAT(col[2]), ca = (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha) ? 255 : IM_F32_TO_INT8_SAT(col[3]); + char buf[64]; + ImFormatString(buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf), "(%.3ff, %.3ff, %.3ff, %.3ff)", col[0], col[1], col[2], (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha) ? 1.0f : col[3]); + if (Selectable(buf)) + SetClipboardText(buf); + ImFormatString(buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf), "(%d,%d,%d,%d)", cr, cg, cb, ca); + if (Selectable(buf)) + SetClipboardText(buf); + ImFormatString(buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf), "#%02X%02X%02X", cr, cg, cb); + if (Selectable(buf)) + SetClipboardText(buf); + if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha)) + { + ImFormatString(buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf), "#%02X%02X%02X%02X", cr, cg, cb, ca); + if (Selectable(buf)) + SetClipboardText(buf); + } + EndPopup(); + } + + g.ColorEditOptions = opts; + EndPopup(); +} + +void ImGui::ColorPickerOptionsPopup(const float* ref_col, ImGuiColorEditFlags flags) +{ + bool allow_opt_picker = !(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_PickerMask_); + bool allow_opt_alpha_bar = !(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha) && !(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaBar); + if ((!allow_opt_picker && !allow_opt_alpha_bar) || !BeginPopup("context")) + return; + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + if (allow_opt_picker) + { + ImVec2 picker_size(g.FontSize * 8, ImMax(g.FontSize * 8 - (GetFrameHeight() + g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x), 1.0f)); // FIXME: Picker size copied from main picker function + PushItemWidth(picker_size.x); + for (int picker_type = 0; picker_type < 2; picker_type++) + { + // Draw small/thumbnail version of each picker type (over an invisible button for selection) + if (picker_type > 0) Separator(); + PushID(picker_type); + ImGuiColorEditFlags picker_flags = ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoInputs | ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoOptions | ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoLabel | ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoSidePreview | (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha); + if (picker_type == 0) picker_flags |= ImGuiColorEditFlags_PickerHueBar; + if (picker_type == 1) picker_flags |= ImGuiColorEditFlags_PickerHueWheel; + ImVec2 backup_pos = GetCursorScreenPos(); + if (Selectable("##selectable", false, 0, picker_size)) // By default, Selectable() is closing popup + g.ColorEditOptions = (g.ColorEditOptions & ~ImGuiColorEditFlags_PickerMask_) | (picker_flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_PickerMask_); + SetCursorScreenPos(backup_pos); + ImVec4 previewing_ref_col; + memcpy(&previewing_ref_col, ref_col, sizeof(float) * ((picker_flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha) ? 3 : 4)); + ColorPicker4("##previewing_picker", &previewing_ref_col.x, picker_flags); + PopID(); + } + PopItemWidth(); + } + if (allow_opt_alpha_bar) + { + if (allow_opt_picker) Separator(); + CheckboxFlags("Alpha Bar", &g.ColorEditOptions, ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaBar); + } + EndPopup(); +} + +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Widgets: TreeNode, CollapsingHeader, etc. +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// - TreeNode() +// - TreeNodeV() +// - TreeNodeEx() +// - TreeNodeExV() +// - TreeNodeBehavior() [Internal] +// - TreePush() +// - TreePop() +// - GetTreeNodeToLabelSpacing() +// - SetNextItemOpen() +// - CollapsingHeader() +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +bool ImGui::TreeNode(const char* str_id, const char* fmt, ...) +{ + va_list args; + va_start(args, fmt); + bool is_open = TreeNodeExV(str_id, 0, fmt, args); + va_end(args); + return is_open; +} + +bool ImGui::TreeNode(const void* ptr_id, const char* fmt, ...) +{ + va_list args; + va_start(args, fmt); + bool is_open = TreeNodeExV(ptr_id, 0, fmt, args); + va_end(args); + return is_open; +} + +bool ImGui::TreeNode(const char* label) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + if (window->SkipItems) + return false; + return TreeNodeBehavior(window->GetID(label), 0, label, NULL); +} + +bool ImGui::TreeNodeV(const char* str_id, const char* fmt, va_list args) +{ + return TreeNodeExV(str_id, 0, fmt, args); +} + +bool ImGui::TreeNodeV(const void* ptr_id, const char* fmt, va_list args) +{ + return TreeNodeExV(ptr_id, 0, fmt, args); +} + +bool ImGui::TreeNodeEx(const char* label, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + if (window->SkipItems) + return false; + + return TreeNodeBehavior(window->GetID(label), flags, label, NULL); +} + +bool ImGui::TreeNodeEx(const char* str_id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags, const char* fmt, ...) +{ + va_list args; + va_start(args, fmt); + bool is_open = TreeNodeExV(str_id, flags, fmt, args); + va_end(args); + return is_open; +} + +bool ImGui::TreeNodeEx(const void* ptr_id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags, const char* fmt, ...) +{ + va_list args; + va_start(args, fmt); + bool is_open = TreeNodeExV(ptr_id, flags, fmt, args); + va_end(args); + return is_open; +} + +bool ImGui::TreeNodeExV(const char* str_id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags, const char* fmt, va_list args) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + if (window->SkipItems) + return false; + + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + const char* label_end = g.TempBuffer + ImFormatStringV(g.TempBuffer, IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.TempBuffer), fmt, args); + return TreeNodeBehavior(window->GetID(str_id), flags, g.TempBuffer, label_end); +} + +bool ImGui::TreeNodeExV(const void* ptr_id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags, const char* fmt, va_list args) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + if (window->SkipItems) + return false; + + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + const char* label_end = g.TempBuffer + ImFormatStringV(g.TempBuffer, IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.TempBuffer), fmt, args); + return TreeNodeBehavior(window->GetID(ptr_id), flags, g.TempBuffer, label_end); +} + +bool ImGui::TreeNodeBehaviorIsOpen(ImGuiID id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags) +{ + if (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Leaf) + return true; + + // We only write to the tree storage if the user clicks (or explicitly use the SetNextItemOpen function) + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + ImGuiStorage* storage = window->DC.StateStorage; + + bool is_open; + if (g.NextItemData.Flags & ImGuiNextItemDataFlags_HasOpen) + { + if (g.NextItemData.OpenCond & ImGuiCond_Always) + { + is_open = g.NextItemData.OpenVal; + storage->SetInt(id, is_open); + } + else + { + // We treat ImGuiCond_Once and ImGuiCond_FirstUseEver the same because tree node state are not saved persistently. + const int stored_value = storage->GetInt(id, -1); + if (stored_value == -1) + { + is_open = g.NextItemData.OpenVal; + storage->SetInt(id, is_open); + } + else + { + is_open = stored_value != 0; + } + } + } + else + { + is_open = storage->GetInt(id, (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_DefaultOpen) ? 1 : 0) != 0; + } + + // When logging is enabled, we automatically expand tree nodes (but *NOT* collapsing headers.. seems like sensible behavior). + // NB- If we are above max depth we still allow manually opened nodes to be logged. + if (g.LogEnabled && !(flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NoAutoOpenOnLog) && (window->DC.TreeDepth - g.LogDepthRef) < g.LogDepthToExpand) + is_open = true; + + return is_open; +} + +bool ImGui::TreeNodeBehavior(ImGuiID id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags, const char* label, const char* label_end) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + if (window->SkipItems) + return false; + + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style; + const bool display_frame = (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Framed) != 0; + const ImVec2 padding = (display_frame || (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_FramePadding)) ? style.FramePadding : ImVec2(style.FramePadding.x, ImMin(window->DC.CurrLineTextBaseOffset, style.FramePadding.y)); + + if (!label_end) + label_end = FindRenderedTextEnd(label); + const ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, label_end, false); + + // We vertically grow up to current line height up the typical widget height. + const float frame_height = ImMax(ImMin(window->DC.CurrLineSize.y, g.FontSize + style.FramePadding.y * 2), label_size.y + padding.y * 2); + ImRect frame_bb; + frame_bb.Min.x = (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_SpanFullWidth) ? window->WorkRect.Min.x : window->DC.CursorPos.x; + frame_bb.Min.y = window->DC.CursorPos.y; + frame_bb.Max.x = window->WorkRect.Max.x; + frame_bb.Max.y = window->DC.CursorPos.y + frame_height; + if (display_frame) + { + // Framed header expand a little outside the default padding, to the edge of InnerClipRect + // (FIXME: May remove this at some point and make InnerClipRect align with WindowPadding.x instead of WindowPadding.x*0.5f) + frame_bb.Min.x -= IM_FLOOR(window->WindowPadding.x * 0.5f - 1.0f); + frame_bb.Max.x += IM_FLOOR(window->WindowPadding.x * 0.5f); + } + + const float text_offset_x = g.FontSize + (display_frame ? padding.x * 3 : padding.x * 2); // Collapser arrow width + Spacing + const float text_offset_y = ImMax(padding.y, window->DC.CurrLineTextBaseOffset); // Latch before ItemSize changes it + const float text_width = g.FontSize + (label_size.x > 0.0f ? label_size.x + padding.x * 2 : 0.0f); // Include collapser + ImVec2 text_pos(window->DC.CursorPos.x + text_offset_x, window->DC.CursorPos.y + text_offset_y); + ItemSize(ImVec2(text_width, frame_height), padding.y); + + // For regular tree nodes, we arbitrary allow to click past 2 worth of ItemSpacing + ImRect interact_bb = frame_bb; + if (!display_frame && (flags & (ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_SpanAvailWidth | ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_SpanFullWidth)) == 0) + interact_bb.Max.x = frame_bb.Min.x + text_width + style.ItemSpacing.x * 2.0f; + + // Store a flag for the current depth to tell if we will allow closing this node when navigating one of its child. + // For this purpose we essentially compare if g.NavIdIsAlive went from 0 to 1 between TreeNode() and TreePop(). + // This is currently only support 32 level deep and we are fine with (1 << Depth) overflowing into a zero. + const bool is_leaf = (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Leaf) != 0; + bool is_open = TreeNodeBehaviorIsOpen(id, flags); + if (is_open && !g.NavIdIsAlive && (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NavLeftJumpsBackHere) && !(flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NoTreePushOnOpen)) + window->DC.TreeJumpToParentOnPopMask |= (1 << window->DC.TreeDepth); + + bool item_add = ItemAdd(interact_bb, id); + g.LastItemData.StatusFlags |= ImGuiItemStatusFlags_HasDisplayRect; + g.LastItemData.DisplayRect = frame_bb; + + if (!item_add) + { + if (is_open && !(flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NoTreePushOnOpen)) + TreePushOverrideID(id); + IMGUI_TEST_ENGINE_ITEM_INFO(g.LastItemData.ID, label, g.LastItemData.StatusFlags | (is_leaf ? 0 : ImGuiItemStatusFlags_Openable) | (is_open ? ImGuiItemStatusFlags_Opened : 0)); + return is_open; + } + + ImGuiButtonFlags button_flags = ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_None; + if (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_AllowItemOverlap) + button_flags |= ImGuiButtonFlags_AllowItemOverlap; + if (!is_leaf) + button_flags |= ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnDragDropHold; + + // We allow clicking on the arrow section with keyboard modifiers held, in order to easily + // allow browsing a tree while preserving selection with code implementing multi-selection patterns. + // When clicking on the rest of the tree node we always disallow keyboard modifiers. + const float arrow_hit_x1 = (text_pos.x - text_offset_x) - style.TouchExtraPadding.x; + const float arrow_hit_x2 = (text_pos.x - text_offset_x) + (g.FontSize + padding.x * 2.0f) + style.TouchExtraPadding.x; + const bool is_mouse_x_over_arrow = (g.IO.MousePos.x >= arrow_hit_x1 && g.IO.MousePos.x < arrow_hit_x2); + if (window != g.HoveredWindow || !is_mouse_x_over_arrow) + button_flags |= ImGuiButtonFlags_NoKeyModifiers; + + // Open behaviors can be altered with the _OpenOnArrow and _OnOnDoubleClick flags. + // Some alteration have subtle effects (e.g. toggle on MouseUp vs MouseDown events) due to requirements for multi-selection and drag and drop support. + // - Single-click on label = Toggle on MouseUp (default, when _OpenOnArrow=0) + // - Single-click on arrow = Toggle on MouseDown (when _OpenOnArrow=0) + // - Single-click on arrow = Toggle on MouseDown (when _OpenOnArrow=1) + // - Double-click on label = Toggle on MouseDoubleClick (when _OpenOnDoubleClick=1) + // - Double-click on arrow = Toggle on MouseDoubleClick (when _OpenOnDoubleClick=1 and _OpenOnArrow=0) + // It is rather standard that arrow click react on Down rather than Up. + // We set ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClickRelease on OpenOnDoubleClick because we want the item to be active on the initial MouseDown in order for drag and drop to work. + if (is_mouse_x_over_arrow) + button_flags |= ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClick; + else if (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_OpenOnDoubleClick) + button_flags |= ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClickRelease | ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnDoubleClick; + else + button_flags |= ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClickRelease; + + bool selected = (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Selected) != 0; + const bool was_selected = selected; + + bool hovered, held; + bool pressed = ButtonBehavior(interact_bb, id, &hovered, &held, button_flags); + bool toggled = false; + if (!is_leaf) + { + if (pressed && g.DragDropHoldJustPressedId != id) + { + if ((flags & (ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_OpenOnArrow | ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_OpenOnDoubleClick)) == 0 || (g.NavActivateId == id)) + toggled = true; + if (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_OpenOnArrow) + toggled |= is_mouse_x_over_arrow && !g.NavDisableMouseHover; // Lightweight equivalent of IsMouseHoveringRect() since ButtonBehavior() already did the job + if ((flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_OpenOnDoubleClick) && g.IO.MouseDoubleClicked[0]) + toggled = true; + } + else if (pressed && g.DragDropHoldJustPressedId == id) + { + IM_ASSERT(button_flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnDragDropHold); + if (!is_open) // When using Drag and Drop "hold to open" we keep the node highlighted after opening, but never close it again. + toggled = true; + } + + if (g.NavId == id && g.NavMoveRequest && g.NavMoveDir == ImGuiDir_Left && is_open) + { + toggled = true; + NavMoveRequestCancel(); + } + if (g.NavId == id && g.NavMoveRequest && g.NavMoveDir == ImGuiDir_Right && !is_open) // If there's something upcoming on the line we may want to give it the priority? + { + toggled = true; + NavMoveRequestCancel(); + } + + if (toggled) + { + is_open = !is_open; + window->DC.StateStorage->SetInt(id, is_open); + g.LastItemData.StatusFlags |= ImGuiItemStatusFlags_ToggledOpen; + } + } + if (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_AllowItemOverlap) + SetItemAllowOverlap(); + + // In this branch, TreeNodeBehavior() cannot toggle the selection so this will never trigger. + if (selected != was_selected) //-V547 + g.LastItemData.StatusFlags |= ImGuiItemStatusFlags_ToggledSelection; + + // Render + const ImU32 text_col = GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text); + ImGuiNavHighlightFlags nav_highlight_flags = ImGuiNavHighlightFlags_TypeThin; + if (display_frame) + { + // Framed type + const ImU32 bg_col = GetColorU32((held && hovered) ? ImGuiCol_HeaderActive : hovered ? ImGuiCol_HeaderHovered : ImGuiCol_Header); + RenderFrame(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max, bg_col, true, style.FrameRounding); + RenderNavHighlight(frame_bb, id, nav_highlight_flags); + if (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Bullet) + RenderBullet(window->DrawList, ImVec2(text_pos.x - text_offset_x * 0.60f, text_pos.y + g.FontSize * 0.5f), text_col); + else if (!is_leaf) + RenderArrow(window->DrawList, ImVec2(text_pos.x - text_offset_x + padding.x, text_pos.y), text_col, is_open ? ImGuiDir_Down : ImGuiDir_Right, 1.0f); + else // Leaf without bullet, left-adjusted text + text_pos.x -= text_offset_x; + if (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_ClipLabelForTrailingButton) + frame_bb.Max.x -= g.FontSize + style.FramePadding.x; + + if (g.LogEnabled) + LogSetNextTextDecoration("###", "###"); + RenderTextClipped(text_pos, frame_bb.Max, label, label_end, &label_size); + } + else + { + // Unframed typed for tree nodes + if (hovered || selected) + { + const ImU32 bg_col = GetColorU32((held && hovered) ? ImGuiCol_HeaderActive : hovered ? ImGuiCol_HeaderHovered : ImGuiCol_Header); + RenderFrame(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max, bg_col, false); + } + RenderNavHighlight(frame_bb, id, nav_highlight_flags); + if (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Bullet) + RenderBullet(window->DrawList, ImVec2(text_pos.x - text_offset_x * 0.5f, text_pos.y + g.FontSize * 0.5f), text_col); + else if (!is_leaf) + RenderArrow(window->DrawList, ImVec2(text_pos.x - text_offset_x + padding.x, text_pos.y + g.FontSize * 0.15f), text_col, is_open ? ImGuiDir_Down : ImGuiDir_Right, 0.70f); + if (g.LogEnabled) + LogSetNextTextDecoration(">", NULL); + RenderText(text_pos, label, label_end, false); + } + + if (is_open && !(flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NoTreePushOnOpen)) + TreePushOverrideID(id); + IMGUI_TEST_ENGINE_ITEM_INFO(id, label, g.LastItemData.StatusFlags | (is_leaf ? 0 : ImGuiItemStatusFlags_Openable) | (is_open ? ImGuiItemStatusFlags_Opened : 0)); + return is_open; +} + +void ImGui::TreePush(const char* str_id) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + Indent(); + window->DC.TreeDepth++; + PushID(str_id ? str_id : "#TreePush"); +} + +void ImGui::TreePush(const void* ptr_id) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + Indent(); + window->DC.TreeDepth++; + PushID(ptr_id ? ptr_id : (const void*)"#TreePush"); +} + +void ImGui::TreePushOverrideID(ImGuiID id) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + Indent(); + window->DC.TreeDepth++; + window->IDStack.push_back(id); +} + +void ImGui::TreePop() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + Unindent(); + + window->DC.TreeDepth--; + ImU32 tree_depth_mask = (1 << window->DC.TreeDepth); + + // Handle Left arrow to move to parent tree node (when ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NavLeftJumpsBackHere is enabled) + if (g.NavMoveDir == ImGuiDir_Left && g.NavWindow == window && NavMoveRequestButNoResultYet()) + if (g.NavIdIsAlive && (window->DC.TreeJumpToParentOnPopMask & tree_depth_mask)) + { + SetNavID(window->IDStack.back(), g.NavLayer, 0, ImRect()); + NavMoveRequestCancel(); + } + window->DC.TreeJumpToParentOnPopMask &= tree_depth_mask - 1; + + IM_ASSERT(window->IDStack.Size > 1); // There should always be 1 element in the IDStack (pushed during window creation). If this triggers you called TreePop/PopID too much. + PopID(); +} + +// Horizontal distance preceding label when using TreeNode() or Bullet() +float ImGui::GetTreeNodeToLabelSpacing() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + return g.FontSize + (g.Style.FramePadding.x * 2.0f); +} + +// Set next TreeNode/CollapsingHeader open state. +void ImGui::SetNextItemOpen(bool is_open, ImGuiCond cond) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + if (g.CurrentWindow->SkipItems) + return; + g.NextItemData.Flags |= ImGuiNextItemDataFlags_HasOpen; + g.NextItemData.OpenVal = is_open; + g.NextItemData.OpenCond = cond ? cond : ImGuiCond_Always; +} + +// CollapsingHeader returns true when opened but do not indent nor push into the ID stack (because of the ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NoTreePushOnOpen flag). +// This is basically the same as calling TreeNodeEx(label, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_CollapsingHeader). You can remove the _NoTreePushOnOpen flag if you want behavior closer to normal TreeNode(). +bool ImGui::CollapsingHeader(const char* label, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + if (window->SkipItems) + return false; + + return TreeNodeBehavior(window->GetID(label), flags | ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_CollapsingHeader, label); +} + +// p_visible == NULL : regular collapsing header +// p_visible != NULL && *p_visible == true : show a small close button on the corner of the header, clicking the button will set *p_visible = false +// p_visible != NULL && *p_visible == false : do not show the header at all +// Do not mistake this with the Open state of the header itself, which you can adjust with SetNextItemOpen() or ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_DefaultOpen. +bool ImGui::CollapsingHeader(const char* label, bool* p_visible, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + if (window->SkipItems) + return false; + + if (p_visible && !*p_visible) + return false; + + ImGuiID id = window->GetID(label); + flags |= ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_CollapsingHeader; + if (p_visible) + flags |= ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_AllowItemOverlap | ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_ClipLabelForTrailingButton; + bool is_open = TreeNodeBehavior(id, flags, label); + if (p_visible != NULL) + { + // Create a small overlapping close button + // FIXME: We can evolve this into user accessible helpers to add extra buttons on title bars, headers, etc. + // FIXME: CloseButton can overlap into text, need find a way to clip the text somehow. + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiLastItemData last_item_backup = g.LastItemData; + float button_size = g.FontSize; + float button_x = ImMax(g.LastItemData.Rect.Min.x, g.LastItemData.Rect.Max.x - g.Style.FramePadding.x * 2.0f - button_size); + float button_y = g.LastItemData.Rect.Min.y; + ImGuiID close_button_id = GetIDWithSeed("#CLOSE", NULL, id); + if (CloseButton(close_button_id, ImVec2(button_x, button_y))) + *p_visible = false; + g.LastItemData = last_item_backup; + } + + return is_open; +} + +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Widgets: Selectable +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// - Selectable() +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// Tip: pass a non-visible label (e.g. "##hello") then you can use the space to draw other text or image. +// But you need to make sure the ID is unique, e.g. enclose calls in PushID/PopID or use ##unique_id. +// With this scheme, ImGuiSelectableFlags_SpanAllColumns and ImGuiSelectableFlags_AllowItemOverlap are also frequently used flags. +// FIXME: Selectable() with (size.x == 0.0f) and (SelectableTextAlign.x > 0.0f) followed by SameLine() is currently not supported. +bool ImGui::Selectable(const char* label, bool selected, ImGuiSelectableFlags flags, const ImVec2& size_arg) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + if (window->SkipItems) + return false; + + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style; + + // Submit label or explicit size to ItemSize(), whereas ItemAdd() will submit a larger/spanning rectangle. + ImGuiID id = window->GetID(label); + ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true); + ImVec2 size(size_arg.x != 0.0f ? size_arg.x : label_size.x, size_arg.y != 0.0f ? size_arg.y : label_size.y); + ImVec2 pos = window->DC.CursorPos; + pos.y += window->DC.CurrLineTextBaseOffset; + ItemSize(size, 0.0f); + + // Fill horizontal space + // We don't support (size < 0.0f) in Selectable() because the ItemSpacing extension would make explicitly right-aligned sizes not visibly match other widgets. + const bool span_all_columns = (flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_SpanAllColumns) != 0; + const float min_x = span_all_columns ? window->ParentWorkRect.Min.x : pos.x; + const float max_x = span_all_columns ? window->ParentWorkRect.Max.x : window->WorkRect.Max.x; + if (size_arg.x == 0.0f || (flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_SpanAvailWidth)) + size.x = ImMax(label_size.x, max_x - min_x); + + // Text stays at the submission position, but bounding box may be extended on both sides + const ImVec2 text_min = pos; + const ImVec2 text_max(min_x + size.x, pos.y + size.y); + + // Selectables are meant to be tightly packed together with no click-gap, so we extend their box to cover spacing between selectable. + ImRect bb(min_x, pos.y, text_max.x, text_max.y); + if ((flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_NoPadWithHalfSpacing) == 0) + { + const float spacing_x = span_all_columns ? 0.0f : style.ItemSpacing.x; + const float spacing_y = style.ItemSpacing.y; + const float spacing_L = IM_FLOOR(spacing_x * 0.50f); + const float spacing_U = IM_FLOOR(spacing_y * 0.50f); + bb.Min.x -= spacing_L; + bb.Min.y -= spacing_U; + bb.Max.x += (spacing_x - spacing_L); + bb.Max.y += (spacing_y - spacing_U); + } + //if (g.IO.KeyCtrl) { GetForegroundDrawList()->AddRect(bb.Min, bb.Max, IM_COL32(0, 255, 0, 255)); } + + // Modify ClipRect for the ItemAdd(), faster than doing a PushColumnsBackground/PushTableBackground for every Selectable.. + const float backup_clip_rect_min_x = window->ClipRect.Min.x; + const float backup_clip_rect_max_x = window->ClipRect.Max.x; + if (span_all_columns) + { + window->ClipRect.Min.x = window->ParentWorkRect.Min.x; + window->ClipRect.Max.x = window->ParentWorkRect.Max.x; + } + + bool item_add; + const bool disabled_item = (flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_Disabled) != 0; + if (disabled_item) + { + ImGuiItemFlags backup_item_flags = g.CurrentItemFlags; + g.CurrentItemFlags |= ImGuiItemFlags_Disabled; + item_add = ItemAdd(bb, id); + g.CurrentItemFlags = backup_item_flags; + } + else + { + item_add = ItemAdd(bb, id); + } + + if (span_all_columns) + { + window->ClipRect.Min.x = backup_clip_rect_min_x; + window->ClipRect.Max.x = backup_clip_rect_max_x; + } + + if (!item_add) + return false; + + const bool disabled_global = (g.CurrentItemFlags & ImGuiItemFlags_Disabled) != 0; + if (disabled_item && !disabled_global) // Only testing this as an optimization + BeginDisabled(true); + + // FIXME: We can standardize the behavior of those two, we could also keep the fast path of override ClipRect + full push on render only, + // which would be advantageous since most selectable are not selected. + if (span_all_columns && window->DC.CurrentColumns) + PushColumnsBackground(); + else if (span_all_columns && g.CurrentTable) + TablePushBackgroundChannel(); + + // We use NoHoldingActiveID on menus so user can click and _hold_ on a menu then drag to browse child entries + ImGuiButtonFlags button_flags = 0; + if (flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_NoHoldingActiveID) { button_flags |= ImGuiButtonFlags_NoHoldingActiveId; } + if (flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_SelectOnClick) { button_flags |= ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClick; } + if (flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_SelectOnRelease) { button_flags |= ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnRelease; } + if (flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_AllowDoubleClick) { button_flags |= ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClickRelease | ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnDoubleClick; } + if (flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_AllowItemOverlap) { button_flags |= ImGuiButtonFlags_AllowItemOverlap; } + + const bool was_selected = selected; + bool hovered, held; + bool pressed = ButtonBehavior(bb, id, &hovered, &held, button_flags); + + // Auto-select when moved into + // - This will be more fully fleshed in the range-select branch + // - This is not exposed as it won't nicely work with some user side handling of shift/control + // - We cannot do 'if (g.NavJustMovedToId != id) { selected = false; pressed = was_selected; }' for two reasons + // - (1) it would require focus scope to be set, need exposing PushFocusScope() or equivalent (e.g. BeginSelection() calling PushFocusScope()) + // - (2) usage will fail with clipped items + // The multi-select API aim to fix those issues, e.g. may be replaced with a BeginSelection() API. + if ((flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_SelectOnNav) && g.NavJustMovedToId != 0 && g.NavJustMovedToFocusScopeId == window->DC.NavFocusScopeIdCurrent) + if (g.NavJustMovedToId == id) + selected = pressed = true; + + // Update NavId when clicking or when Hovering (this doesn't happen on most widgets), so navigation can be resumed with gamepad/keyboard + if (pressed || (hovered && (flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_SetNavIdOnHover))) + { + if (!g.NavDisableMouseHover && g.NavWindow == window && g.NavLayer == window->DC.NavLayerCurrent) + { + SetNavID(id, window->DC.NavLayerCurrent, window->DC.NavFocusScopeIdCurrent, ImRect(bb.Min - window->Pos, bb.Max - window->Pos)); + g.NavDisableHighlight = true; + } + } + if (pressed) + MarkItemEdited(id); + + if (flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_AllowItemOverlap) + SetItemAllowOverlap(); + + // In this branch, Selectable() cannot toggle the selection so this will never trigger. + if (selected != was_selected) //-V547 + g.LastItemData.StatusFlags |= ImGuiItemStatusFlags_ToggledSelection; + + // Render + if (held && (flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_DrawHoveredWhenHeld)) + hovered = true; + if (hovered || selected) + { + const ImU32 col = GetColorU32((held && hovered) ? ImGuiCol_HeaderActive : hovered ? ImGuiCol_HeaderHovered : ImGuiCol_Header); + RenderFrame(bb.Min, bb.Max, col, false, 0.0f); + } + RenderNavHighlight(bb, id, ImGuiNavHighlightFlags_TypeThin | ImGuiNavHighlightFlags_NoRounding); + + if (span_all_columns && window->DC.CurrentColumns) + PopColumnsBackground(); + else if (span_all_columns && g.CurrentTable) + TablePopBackgroundChannel(); + + RenderTextClipped(text_min, text_max, label, NULL, &label_size, style.SelectableTextAlign, &bb); + + // Automatically close popups + if (pressed && (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup) && !(flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_DontClosePopups) && !(g.LastItemData.InFlags & ImGuiItemFlags_SelectableDontClosePopup)) + CloseCurrentPopup(); + + if (disabled_item && !disabled_global) + EndDisabled(); + + IMGUI_TEST_ENGINE_ITEM_INFO(id, label, g.LastItemData.StatusFlags); + return pressed; //-V1020 +} + +bool ImGui::Selectable(const char* label, bool* p_selected, ImGuiSelectableFlags flags, const ImVec2& size_arg) +{ + if (Selectable(label, *p_selected, flags, size_arg)) + { + *p_selected = !*p_selected; + return true; + } + return false; +} + +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Widgets: ListBox +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// - BeginListBox() +// - EndListBox() +// - ListBox() +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// Tip: To have a list filling the entire window width, use size.x = -FLT_MIN and pass an non-visible label e.g. "##empty" +// Tip: If your vertical size is calculated from an item count (e.g. 10 * item_height) consider adding a fractional part to facilitate seeing scrolling boundaries (e.g. 10.25 * item_height). +bool ImGui::BeginListBox(const char* label, const ImVec2& size_arg) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + if (window->SkipItems) + return false; + + const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style; + const ImGuiID id = GetID(label); + const ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true); + + // Size default to hold ~7.25 items. + // Fractional number of items helps seeing that we can scroll down/up without looking at scrollbar. + ImVec2 size = ImFloor(CalcItemSize(size_arg, CalcItemWidth(), GetTextLineHeightWithSpacing() * 7.25f + style.FramePadding.y * 2.0f)); + ImVec2 frame_size = ImVec2(size.x, ImMax(size.y, label_size.y)); + ImRect frame_bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + frame_size); + ImRect bb(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max + ImVec2(label_size.x > 0.0f ? style.ItemInnerSpacing.x + label_size.x : 0.0f, 0.0f)); + g.NextItemData.ClearFlags(); + + if (!IsRectVisible(bb.Min, bb.Max)) + { + ItemSize(bb.GetSize(), style.FramePadding.y); + ItemAdd(bb, 0, &frame_bb); + return false; + } + + // FIXME-OPT: We could omit the BeginGroup() if label_size.x but would need to omit the EndGroup() as well. + BeginGroup(); + if (label_size.x > 0.0f) + { + ImVec2 label_pos = ImVec2(frame_bb.Max.x + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x, frame_bb.Min.y + style.FramePadding.y); + RenderText(label_pos, label); + window->DC.CursorMaxPos = ImMax(window->DC.CursorMaxPos, label_pos + label_size); + } + + BeginChildFrame(id, frame_bb.GetSize()); + return true; +} + +#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_OBSOLETE_FUNCTIONS +// OBSOLETED in 1.81 (from February 2021) +bool ImGui::ListBoxHeader(const char* label, int items_count, int height_in_items) +{ + // If height_in_items == -1, default height is maximum 7. + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + float height_in_items_f = (height_in_items < 0 ? ImMin(items_count, 7) : height_in_items) + 0.25f; + ImVec2 size; + size.x = 0.0f; + size.y = GetTextLineHeightWithSpacing() * height_in_items_f + g.Style.FramePadding.y * 2.0f; + return BeginListBox(label, size); +} +#endif + +void ImGui::EndListBox() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + IM_ASSERT((window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow) && "Mismatched BeginListBox/EndListBox calls. Did you test the return value of BeginListBox?"); + IM_UNUSED(window); + + EndChildFrame(); + EndGroup(); // This is only required to be able to do IsItemXXX query on the whole ListBox including label +} + +bool ImGui::ListBox(const char* label, int* current_item, const char* const items[], int items_count, int height_items) +{ + const bool value_changed = ListBox(label, current_item, Items_ArrayGetter, (void*)items, items_count, height_items); + return value_changed; +} + +// This is merely a helper around BeginListBox(), EndListBox(). +// Considering using those directly to submit custom data or store selection differently. +bool ImGui::ListBox(const char* label, int* current_item, bool (*items_getter)(void*, int, const char**), void* data, int items_count, int height_in_items) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + + // Calculate size from "height_in_items" + if (height_in_items < 0) + height_in_items = ImMin(items_count, 7); + float height_in_items_f = height_in_items + 0.25f; + ImVec2 size(0.0f, ImFloor(GetTextLineHeightWithSpacing() * height_in_items_f + g.Style.FramePadding.y * 2.0f)); + + if (!BeginListBox(label, size)) + return false; + + // Assume all items have even height (= 1 line of text). If you need items of different height, + // you can create a custom version of ListBox() in your code without using the clipper. + bool value_changed = false; + ImGuiListClipper clipper; + clipper.Begin(items_count, GetTextLineHeightWithSpacing()); // We know exactly our line height here so we pass it as a minor optimization, but generally you don't need to. + while (clipper.Step()) + for (int i = clipper.DisplayStart; i < clipper.DisplayEnd; i++) + { + const char* item_text; + if (!items_getter(data, i, &item_text)) + item_text = "*Unknown item*"; + + PushID(i); + const bool item_selected = (i == *current_item); + if (Selectable(item_text, item_selected)) + { + *current_item = i; + value_changed = true; + } + if (item_selected) + SetItemDefaultFocus(); + PopID(); + } + EndListBox(); + + if (value_changed) + MarkItemEdited(g.LastItemData.ID); + + return value_changed; +} + +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Widgets: PlotLines, PlotHistogram +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// - PlotEx() [Internal] +// - PlotLines() +// - PlotHistogram() +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// Plot/Graph widgets are not very good. +// Consider writing your own, or using a third-party one, see: +// - ImPlot https://github.com/epezent/implot +// - others https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/wiki/Useful-Extensions +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +int ImGui::PlotEx(ImGuiPlotType plot_type, const char* label, float (*values_getter)(void* data, int idx), void* data, int values_count, int values_offset, const char* overlay_text, float scale_min, float scale_max, ImVec2 frame_size) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + if (window->SkipItems) + return -1; + + const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style; + const ImGuiID id = window->GetID(label); + + const ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true); + if (frame_size.x == 0.0f) + frame_size.x = CalcItemWidth(); + if (frame_size.y == 0.0f) + frame_size.y = label_size.y + (style.FramePadding.y * 2); + + const ImRect frame_bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + frame_size); + const ImRect inner_bb(frame_bb.Min + style.FramePadding, frame_bb.Max - style.FramePadding); + const ImRect total_bb(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max + ImVec2(label_size.x > 0.0f ? style.ItemInnerSpacing.x + label_size.x : 0.0f, 0)); + ItemSize(total_bb, style.FramePadding.y); + if (!ItemAdd(total_bb, 0, &frame_bb)) + return -1; + const bool hovered = ItemHoverable(frame_bb, id); + + // Determine scale from values if not specified + if (scale_min == FLT_MAX || scale_max == FLT_MAX) + { + float v_min = FLT_MAX; + float v_max = -FLT_MAX; + for (int i = 0; i < values_count; i++) + { + const float v = values_getter(data, i); + if (v != v) // Ignore NaN values + continue; + v_min = ImMin(v_min, v); + v_max = ImMax(v_max, v); + } + if (scale_min == FLT_MAX) + scale_min = v_min; + if (scale_max == FLT_MAX) + scale_max = v_max; + } + + RenderFrame(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_FrameBg), true, style.FrameRounding); + + const int values_count_min = (plot_type == ImGuiPlotType_Lines) ? 2 : 1; + int idx_hovered = -1; + if (values_count >= values_count_min) + { + int res_w = ImMin((int)frame_size.x, values_count) + ((plot_type == ImGuiPlotType_Lines) ? -1 : 0); + int item_count = values_count + ((plot_type == ImGuiPlotType_Lines) ? -1 : 0); + + // Tooltip on hover + if (hovered && inner_bb.Contains(g.IO.MousePos)) + { + const float t = ImClamp((g.IO.MousePos.x - inner_bb.Min.x) / (inner_bb.Max.x - inner_bb.Min.x), 0.0f, 0.9999f); + const int v_idx = (int)(t * item_count); + IM_ASSERT(v_idx >= 0 && v_idx < values_count); + + const float v0 = values_getter(data, (v_idx + values_offset) % values_count); + const float v1 = values_getter(data, (v_idx + 1 + values_offset) % values_count); + if (plot_type == ImGuiPlotType_Lines) + SetTooltip("%d: %8.4g\n%d: %8.4g", v_idx, v0, v_idx + 1, v1); + else if (plot_type == ImGuiPlotType_Histogram) + SetTooltip("%d: %8.4g", v_idx, v0); + idx_hovered = v_idx; + } + + const float t_step = 1.0f / (float)res_w; + const float inv_scale = (scale_min == scale_max) ? 0.0f : (1.0f / (scale_max - scale_min)); + + float v0 = values_getter(data, (0 + values_offset) % values_count); + float t0 = 0.0f; + ImVec2 tp0 = ImVec2( t0, 1.0f - ImSaturate((v0 - scale_min) * inv_scale) ); // Point in the normalized space of our target rectangle + float histogram_zero_line_t = (scale_min * scale_max < 0.0f) ? (-scale_min * inv_scale) : (scale_min < 0.0f ? 0.0f : 1.0f); // Where does the zero line stands + + const ImU32 col_base = GetColorU32((plot_type == ImGuiPlotType_Lines) ? ImGuiCol_PlotLines : ImGuiCol_PlotHistogram); + const ImU32 col_hovered = GetColorU32((plot_type == ImGuiPlotType_Lines) ? ImGuiCol_PlotLinesHovered : ImGuiCol_PlotHistogramHovered); + + for (int n = 0; n < res_w; n++) + { + const float t1 = t0 + t_step; + const int v1_idx = (int)(t0 * item_count + 0.5f); + IM_ASSERT(v1_idx >= 0 && v1_idx < values_count); + const float v1 = values_getter(data, (v1_idx + values_offset + 1) % values_count); + const ImVec2 tp1 = ImVec2( t1, 1.0f - ImSaturate((v1 - scale_min) * inv_scale) ); + + // NB: Draw calls are merged together by the DrawList system. Still, we should render our batch are lower level to save a bit of CPU. + ImVec2 pos0 = ImLerp(inner_bb.Min, inner_bb.Max, tp0); + ImVec2 pos1 = ImLerp(inner_bb.Min, inner_bb.Max, (plot_type == ImGuiPlotType_Lines) ? tp1 : ImVec2(tp1.x, histogram_zero_line_t)); + if (plot_type == ImGuiPlotType_Lines) + { + window->DrawList->AddLine(pos0, pos1, idx_hovered == v1_idx ? col_hovered : col_base); + } + else if (plot_type == ImGuiPlotType_Histogram) + { + if (pos1.x >= pos0.x + 2.0f) + pos1.x -= 1.0f; + window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(pos0, pos1, idx_hovered == v1_idx ? col_hovered : col_base); + } + + t0 = t1; + tp0 = tp1; + } + } + + // Text overlay + if (overlay_text) + RenderTextClipped(ImVec2(frame_bb.Min.x, frame_bb.Min.y + style.FramePadding.y), frame_bb.Max, overlay_text, NULL, NULL, ImVec2(0.5f, 0.0f)); + + if (label_size.x > 0.0f) + RenderText(ImVec2(frame_bb.Max.x + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x, inner_bb.Min.y), label); + + // Return hovered index or -1 if none are hovered. + // This is currently not exposed in the public API because we need a larger redesign of the whole thing, but in the short-term we are making it available in PlotEx(). + return idx_hovered; +} + +struct ImGuiPlotArrayGetterData +{ + const float* Values; + int Stride; + + ImGuiPlotArrayGetterData(const float* values, int stride) { Values = values; Stride = stride; } +}; + +static float Plot_ArrayGetter(void* data, int idx) +{ + ImGuiPlotArrayGetterData* plot_data = (ImGuiPlotArrayGetterData*)data; + const float v = *(const float*)(const void*)((const unsigned char*)plot_data->Values + (size_t)idx * plot_data->Stride); + return v; +} + +void ImGui::PlotLines(const char* label, const float* values, int values_count, int values_offset, const char* overlay_text, float scale_min, float scale_max, ImVec2 graph_size, int stride) +{ + ImGuiPlotArrayGetterData data(values, stride); + PlotEx(ImGuiPlotType_Lines, label, &Plot_ArrayGetter, (void*)&data, values_count, values_offset, overlay_text, scale_min, scale_max, graph_size); +} + +void ImGui::PlotLines(const char* label, float (*values_getter)(void* data, int idx), void* data, int values_count, int values_offset, const char* overlay_text, float scale_min, float scale_max, ImVec2 graph_size) +{ + PlotEx(ImGuiPlotType_Lines, label, values_getter, data, values_count, values_offset, overlay_text, scale_min, scale_max, graph_size); +} + +void ImGui::PlotHistogram(const char* label, const float* values, int values_count, int values_offset, const char* overlay_text, float scale_min, float scale_max, ImVec2 graph_size, int stride) +{ + ImGuiPlotArrayGetterData data(values, stride); + PlotEx(ImGuiPlotType_Histogram, label, &Plot_ArrayGetter, (void*)&data, values_count, values_offset, overlay_text, scale_min, scale_max, graph_size); +} + +void ImGui::PlotHistogram(const char* label, float (*values_getter)(void* data, int idx), void* data, int values_count, int values_offset, const char* overlay_text, float scale_min, float scale_max, ImVec2 graph_size) +{ + PlotEx(ImGuiPlotType_Histogram, label, values_getter, data, values_count, values_offset, overlay_text, scale_min, scale_max, graph_size); +} + +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Widgets: Value helpers +// Those is not very useful, legacy API. +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// - Value() +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +void ImGui::Value(const char* prefix, bool b) +{ + Text("%s: %s", prefix, (b ? "true" : "false")); +} + +void ImGui::Value(const char* prefix, int v) +{ + Text("%s: %d", prefix, v); +} + +void ImGui::Value(const char* prefix, unsigned int v) +{ + Text("%s: %d", prefix, v); +} + +void ImGui::Value(const char* prefix, float v, const char* float_format) +{ + if (float_format) + { + char fmt[64]; + ImFormatString(fmt, IM_ARRAYSIZE(fmt), "%%s: %s", float_format); + Text(fmt, prefix, v); + } + else + { + Text("%s: %.3f", prefix, v); + } +} + +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] MenuItem, BeginMenu, EndMenu, etc. +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// - ImGuiMenuColumns [Internal] +// - BeginMenuBar() +// - EndMenuBar() +// - BeginMainMenuBar() +// - EndMainMenuBar() +// - BeginMenu() +// - EndMenu() +// - MenuItemEx() [Internal] +// - MenuItem() +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// Helpers for internal use +void ImGuiMenuColumns::Update(float spacing, bool window_reappearing) +{ + if (window_reappearing) + memset(Widths, 0, sizeof(Widths)); + Spacing = (ImU16)spacing; + CalcNextTotalWidth(true); + memset(Widths, 0, sizeof(Widths)); + TotalWidth = NextTotalWidth; + NextTotalWidth = 0; +} + +void ImGuiMenuColumns::CalcNextTotalWidth(bool update_offsets) +{ + ImU16 offset = 0; + bool want_spacing = false; + for (int i = 0; i < IM_ARRAYSIZE(Widths); i++) + { + ImU16 width = Widths[i]; + if (want_spacing && width > 0) + offset += Spacing; + want_spacing |= (width > 0); + if (update_offsets) + { + if (i == 1) { OffsetLabel = offset; } + if (i == 2) { OffsetShortcut = offset; } + if (i == 3) { OffsetMark = offset; } + } + offset += width; + } + NextTotalWidth = offset; +} + +float ImGuiMenuColumns::DeclColumns(float w_icon, float w_label, float w_shortcut, float w_mark) +{ + Widths[0] = ImMax(Widths[0], (ImU16)w_icon); + Widths[1] = ImMax(Widths[1], (ImU16)w_label); + Widths[2] = ImMax(Widths[2], (ImU16)w_shortcut); + Widths[3] = ImMax(Widths[3], (ImU16)w_mark); + CalcNextTotalWidth(false); + return (float)ImMax(TotalWidth, NextTotalWidth); +} + +// FIXME: Provided a rectangle perhaps e.g. a BeginMenuBarEx() could be used anywhere.. +// Currently the main responsibility of this function being to setup clip-rect + horizontal layout + menu navigation layer. +// Ideally we also want this to be responsible for claiming space out of the main window scrolling rectangle, in which case ImGuiWindowFlags_MenuBar will become unnecessary. +// Then later the same system could be used for multiple menu-bars, scrollbars, side-bars. +bool ImGui::BeginMenuBar() +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + if (window->SkipItems) + return false; + if (!(window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_MenuBar)) + return false; + + IM_ASSERT(!window->DC.MenuBarAppending); + BeginGroup(); // Backup position on layer 0 // FIXME: Misleading to use a group for that backup/restore + PushID("##menubar"); + + // We don't clip with current window clipping rectangle as it is already set to the area below. However we clip with window full rect. + // We remove 1 worth of rounding to Max.x to that text in long menus and small windows don't tend to display over the lower-right rounded area, which looks particularly glitchy. + ImRect bar_rect = window->MenuBarRect(); + ImRect clip_rect(IM_ROUND(bar_rect.Min.x + window->WindowBorderSize), IM_ROUND(bar_rect.Min.y + window->WindowBorderSize), IM_ROUND(ImMax(bar_rect.Min.x, bar_rect.Max.x - ImMax(window->WindowRounding, window->WindowBorderSize))), IM_ROUND(bar_rect.Max.y)); + clip_rect.ClipWith(window->OuterRectClipped); + PushClipRect(clip_rect.Min, clip_rect.Max, false); + + // We overwrite CursorMaxPos because BeginGroup sets it to CursorPos (essentially the .EmitItem hack in EndMenuBar() would need something analogous here, maybe a BeginGroupEx() with flags). + window->DC.CursorPos = window->DC.CursorMaxPos = ImVec2(bar_rect.Min.x + window->DC.MenuBarOffset.x, bar_rect.Min.y + window->DC.MenuBarOffset.y); + window->DC.LayoutType = ImGuiLayoutType_Horizontal; + window->DC.NavLayerCurrent = ImGuiNavLayer_Menu; + window->DC.MenuBarAppending = true; + AlignTextToFramePadding(); + return true; +} + +void ImGui::EndMenuBar() +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + if (window->SkipItems) + return; + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + + // Nav: When a move request within one of our child menu failed, capture the request to navigate among our siblings. + if (NavMoveRequestButNoResultYet() && (g.NavMoveDir == ImGuiDir_Left || g.NavMoveDir == ImGuiDir_Right) && (g.NavWindow->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildMenu)) + { + ImGuiWindow* nav_earliest_child = g.NavWindow; + while (nav_earliest_child->ParentWindow && (nav_earliest_child->ParentWindow->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildMenu)) + nav_earliest_child = nav_earliest_child->ParentWindow; + if (nav_earliest_child->ParentWindow == window && nav_earliest_child->DC.ParentLayoutType == ImGuiLayoutType_Horizontal && g.NavMoveRequestForward == ImGuiNavForward_None) + { + // To do so we claim focus back, restore NavId and then process the movement request for yet another frame. + // This involve a one-frame delay which isn't very problematic in this situation. We could remove it by scoring in advance for multiple window (probably not worth the hassle/cost) + const ImGuiNavLayer layer = ImGuiNavLayer_Menu; + IM_ASSERT(window->DC.NavLayersActiveMaskNext & (1 << layer)); // Sanity check + FocusWindow(window); + SetNavID(window->NavLastIds[layer], layer, 0, window->NavRectRel[layer]); + g.NavDisableHighlight = true; // Hide highlight for the current frame so we don't see the intermediary selection. + g.NavDisableMouseHover = g.NavMousePosDirty = true; + g.NavMoveRequestForward = ImGuiNavForward_ForwardQueued; + NavMoveRequestCancel(); + } + } + + IM_MSVC_WARNING_SUPPRESS(6011); // Static Analysis false positive "warning C6011: Dereferencing NULL pointer 'window'" + IM_ASSERT(window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_MenuBar); + IM_ASSERT(window->DC.MenuBarAppending); + PopClipRect(); + PopID(); + window->DC.MenuBarOffset.x = window->DC.CursorPos.x - window->Pos.x; // Save horizontal position so next append can reuse it. This is kinda equivalent to a per-layer CursorPos. + g.GroupStack.back().EmitItem = false; + EndGroup(); // Restore position on layer 0 + window->DC.LayoutType = ImGuiLayoutType_Vertical; + window->DC.NavLayerCurrent = ImGuiNavLayer_Main; + window->DC.MenuBarAppending = false; +} + +// Important: calling order matters! +// FIXME: Somehow overlapping with docking tech. +// FIXME: The "rect-cut" aspect of this could be formalized into a lower-level helper (rect-cut: https://halt.software/dead-simple-layouts) +bool ImGui::BeginViewportSideBar(const char* name, ImGuiViewport* viewport_p, ImGuiDir dir, float axis_size, ImGuiWindowFlags window_flags) +{ + IM_ASSERT(dir != ImGuiDir_None); + + ImGuiWindow* bar_window = FindWindowByName(name); + if (bar_window == NULL || bar_window->BeginCount == 0) + { + // Calculate and set window size/position + ImGuiViewportP* viewport = (ImGuiViewportP*)(void*)(viewport_p ? viewport_p : GetMainViewport()); + ImRect avail_rect = viewport->GetBuildWorkRect(); + ImGuiAxis axis = (dir == ImGuiDir_Up || dir == ImGuiDir_Down) ? ImGuiAxis_Y : ImGuiAxis_X; + ImVec2 pos = avail_rect.Min; + if (dir == ImGuiDir_Right || dir == ImGuiDir_Down) + pos[axis] = avail_rect.Max[axis] - axis_size; + ImVec2 size = avail_rect.GetSize(); + size[axis] = axis_size; + SetNextWindowPos(pos); + SetNextWindowSize(size); + + // Report our size into work area (for next frame) using actual window size + if (dir == ImGuiDir_Up || dir == ImGuiDir_Left) + viewport->BuildWorkOffsetMin[axis] += axis_size; + else if (dir == ImGuiDir_Down || dir == ImGuiDir_Right) + viewport->BuildWorkOffsetMax[axis] -= axis_size; + } + + window_flags |= ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoResize | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoMove; + PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_WindowRounding, 0.0f); + PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_WindowMinSize, ImVec2(0, 0)); // Lift normal size constraint + bool is_open = Begin(name, NULL, window_flags); + PopStyleVar(2); + + return is_open; +} + +bool ImGui::BeginMainMenuBar() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiViewportP* viewport = (ImGuiViewportP*)(void*)GetMainViewport(); + + // For the main menu bar, which cannot be moved, we honor g.Style.DisplaySafeAreaPadding to ensure text can be visible on a TV set. + // FIXME: This could be generalized as an opt-in way to clamp window->DC.CursorStartPos to avoid SafeArea? + // FIXME: Consider removing support for safe area down the line... it's messy. Nowadays consoles have support for TV calibration in OS settings. + g.NextWindowData.MenuBarOffsetMinVal = ImVec2(g.Style.DisplaySafeAreaPadding.x, ImMax(g.Style.DisplaySafeAreaPadding.y - g.Style.FramePadding.y, 0.0f)); + ImGuiWindowFlags window_flags = ImGuiWindowFlags_NoScrollbar | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoSavedSettings | ImGuiWindowFlags_MenuBar; + float height = GetFrameHeight(); + bool is_open = BeginViewportSideBar("##MainMenuBar", viewport, ImGuiDir_Up, height, window_flags); + g.NextWindowData.MenuBarOffsetMinVal = ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f); + + if (is_open) + BeginMenuBar(); + else + End(); + return is_open; +} + +void ImGui::EndMainMenuBar() +{ + EndMenuBar(); + + // When the user has left the menu layer (typically: closed menus through activation of an item), we restore focus to the previous window + // FIXME: With this strategy we won't be able to restore a NULL focus. + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + if (g.CurrentWindow == g.NavWindow && g.NavLayer == ImGuiNavLayer_Main && !g.NavAnyRequest) + FocusTopMostWindowUnderOne(g.NavWindow, NULL); + + End(); +} + +bool ImGui::BeginMenu(const char* label, bool enabled) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + if (window->SkipItems) + return false; + + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style; + const ImGuiID id = window->GetID(label); + bool menu_is_open = IsPopupOpen(id, ImGuiPopupFlags_None); + + // Sub-menus are ChildWindow so that mouse can be hovering across them (otherwise top-most popup menu would steal focus and not allow hovering on parent menu) + ImGuiWindowFlags flags = ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildMenu | ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoMove | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoSavedSettings | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoNavFocus; + if (window->Flags & (ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup | ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildMenu)) + flags |= ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow; + + // If a menu with same the ID was already submitted, we will append to it, matching the behavior of Begin(). + // We are relying on a O(N) search - so O(N log N) over the frame - which seems like the most efficient for the expected small amount of BeginMenu() calls per frame. + // If somehow this is ever becoming a problem we can switch to use e.g. ImGuiStorage mapping key to last frame used. + if (g.MenusIdSubmittedThisFrame.contains(id)) + { + if (menu_is_open) + menu_is_open = BeginPopupEx(id, flags); // menu_is_open can be 'false' when the popup is completely clipped (e.g. zero size display) + else + g.NextWindowData.ClearFlags(); // we behave like Begin() and need to consume those values + return menu_is_open; + } + + // Tag menu as used. Next time BeginMenu() with same ID is called it will append to existing menu + g.MenusIdSubmittedThisFrame.push_back(id); + + ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true); + bool pressed; + bool menuset_is_open = !(window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup) && (g.OpenPopupStack.Size > g.BeginPopupStack.Size && g.OpenPopupStack[g.BeginPopupStack.Size].OpenParentId == window->IDStack.back()); + ImGuiWindow* backed_nav_window = g.NavWindow; + if (menuset_is_open) + g.NavWindow = window; // Odd hack to allow hovering across menus of a same menu-set (otherwise we wouldn't be able to hover parent) + + // The reference position stored in popup_pos will be used by Begin() to find a suitable position for the child menu, + // However the final position is going to be different! It is chosen by FindBestWindowPosForPopup(). + // e.g. Menus tend to overlap each other horizontally to amplify relative Z-ordering. + ImVec2 popup_pos, pos = window->DC.CursorPos; + PushID(label); + if (!enabled) + BeginDisabled(); + const ImGuiMenuColumns* offsets = &window->DC.MenuColumns; + if (window->DC.LayoutType == ImGuiLayoutType_Horizontal) + { + // Menu inside an horizontal menu bar + // Selectable extend their highlight by half ItemSpacing in each direction. + // For ChildMenu, the popup position will be overwritten by the call to FindBestWindowPosForPopup() in Begin() + popup_pos = ImVec2(pos.x - 1.0f - IM_FLOOR(style.ItemSpacing.x * 0.5f), pos.y - style.FramePadding.y + window->MenuBarHeight()); + window->DC.CursorPos.x += IM_FLOOR(style.ItemSpacing.x * 0.5f); + PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_ItemSpacing, ImVec2(style.ItemSpacing.x * 2.0f, style.ItemSpacing.y)); + float w = label_size.x; + ImVec2 text_pos(window->DC.CursorPos.x + offsets->OffsetLabel, window->DC.CursorPos.y + window->DC.CurrLineTextBaseOffset); + pressed = Selectable("", menu_is_open, ImGuiSelectableFlags_NoHoldingActiveID | ImGuiSelectableFlags_SelectOnClick | ImGuiSelectableFlags_DontClosePopups, ImVec2(w, 0.0f)); + RenderText(text_pos, label); + PopStyleVar(); + window->DC.CursorPos.x += IM_FLOOR(style.ItemSpacing.x * (-1.0f + 0.5f)); // -1 spacing to compensate the spacing added when Selectable() did a SameLine(). It would also work to call SameLine() ourselves after the PopStyleVar(). + } + else + { + // Menu inside a menu + // (In a typical menu window where all items are BeginMenu() or MenuItem() calls, extra_w will always be 0.0f. + // Only when they are other items sticking out we're going to add spacing, yet only register minimum width into the layout system. + popup_pos = ImVec2(pos.x, pos.y - style.WindowPadding.y); + float icon_w = 0.0f; // FIXME: This not currently exposed for BeginMenu() however you can call window->DC.MenuColumns.DeclColumns(w, 0, 0, 0) yourself + float checkmark_w = IM_FLOOR(g.FontSize * 1.20f); + float min_w = window->DC.MenuColumns.DeclColumns(icon_w, label_size.x, 0.0f, checkmark_w); // Feedback to next frame + float extra_w = ImMax(0.0f, GetContentRegionAvail().x - min_w); + ImVec2 text_pos(window->DC.CursorPos.x + offsets->OffsetLabel, window->DC.CursorPos.y + window->DC.CurrLineTextBaseOffset); + pressed = Selectable("", menu_is_open, ImGuiSelectableFlags_NoHoldingActiveID | ImGuiSelectableFlags_SelectOnClick | ImGuiSelectableFlags_DontClosePopups | ImGuiSelectableFlags_SpanAvailWidth, ImVec2(min_w, 0.0f)); + RenderText(text_pos, label); + RenderArrow(window->DrawList, pos + ImVec2(offsets->OffsetMark + extra_w + g.FontSize * 0.30f, 0.0f), GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text), ImGuiDir_Right); + } + if (!enabled) + EndDisabled(); + + const bool hovered = (g.HoveredId == id) && enabled; + if (menuset_is_open) + g.NavWindow = backed_nav_window; + + bool want_open = false; + bool want_close = false; + if (window->DC.LayoutType == ImGuiLayoutType_Vertical) // (window->Flags & (ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup|ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildMenu)) + { + // Close menu when not hovering it anymore unless we are moving roughly in the direction of the menu + // Implement http://bjk5.com/post/44698559168/breaking-down-amazons-mega-dropdown to avoid using timers, so menus feels more reactive. + bool moving_toward_other_child_menu = false; + + ImGuiWindow* child_menu_window = (g.BeginPopupStack.Size < g.OpenPopupStack.Size && g.OpenPopupStack[g.BeginPopupStack.Size].SourceWindow == window) ? g.OpenPopupStack[g.BeginPopupStack.Size].Window : NULL; + if (g.HoveredWindow == window && child_menu_window != NULL && !(window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_MenuBar)) + { + // FIXME-DPI: Values should be derived from a master "scale" factor. + ImRect next_window_rect = child_menu_window->Rect(); + ImVec2 ta = g.IO.MousePos - g.IO.MouseDelta; + ImVec2 tb = (window->Pos.x < child_menu_window->Pos.x) ? next_window_rect.GetTL() : next_window_rect.GetTR(); + ImVec2 tc = (window->Pos.x < child_menu_window->Pos.x) ? next_window_rect.GetBL() : next_window_rect.GetBR(); + float extra = ImClamp(ImFabs(ta.x - tb.x) * 0.30f, 5.0f, 30.0f); // add a bit of extra slack. + ta.x += (window->Pos.x < child_menu_window->Pos.x) ? -0.5f : +0.5f; // to avoid numerical issues + tb.y = ta.y + ImMax((tb.y - extra) - ta.y, -100.0f); // triangle is maximum 200 high to limit the slope and the bias toward large sub-menus // FIXME: Multiply by fb_scale? + tc.y = ta.y + ImMin((tc.y + extra) - ta.y, +100.0f); + moving_toward_other_child_menu = ImTriangleContainsPoint(ta, tb, tc, g.IO.MousePos); + //GetForegroundDrawList()->AddTriangleFilled(ta, tb, tc, moving_within_opened_triangle ? IM_COL32(0,128,0,128) : IM_COL32(128,0,0,128)); // [DEBUG] + } + + // FIXME: Hovering a disabled BeginMenu or MenuItem won't close us + if (menu_is_open && !hovered && g.HoveredWindow == window && g.HoveredIdPreviousFrame != 0 && g.HoveredIdPreviousFrame != id && !moving_toward_other_child_menu) + want_close = true; + + if (!menu_is_open && hovered && pressed) // Click to open + want_open = true; + else if (!menu_is_open && hovered && !moving_toward_other_child_menu) // Hover to open + want_open = true; + + if (g.NavActivateId == id) + { + want_close = menu_is_open; + want_open = !menu_is_open; + } + if (g.NavId == id && g.NavMoveRequest && g.NavMoveDir == ImGuiDir_Right) // Nav-Right to open + { + want_open = true; + NavMoveRequestCancel(); + } + } + else + { + // Menu bar + if (menu_is_open && pressed && menuset_is_open) // Click an open menu again to close it + { + want_close = true; + want_open = menu_is_open = false; + } + else if (pressed || (hovered && menuset_is_open && !menu_is_open)) // First click to open, then hover to open others + { + want_open = true; + } + else if (g.NavId == id && g.NavMoveRequest && g.NavMoveDir == ImGuiDir_Down) // Nav-Down to open + { + want_open = true; + NavMoveRequestCancel(); + } + } + + if (!enabled) // explicitly close if an open menu becomes disabled, facilitate users code a lot in pattern such as 'if (BeginMenu("options", has_object)) { ..use object.. }' + want_close = true; + if (want_close && IsPopupOpen(id, ImGuiPopupFlags_None)) + ClosePopupToLevel(g.BeginPopupStack.Size, true); + + IMGUI_TEST_ENGINE_ITEM_INFO(id, label, g.LastItemData.StatusFlags | ImGuiItemStatusFlags_Openable | (menu_is_open ? ImGuiItemStatusFlags_Opened : 0)); + PopID(); + + if (!menu_is_open && want_open && g.OpenPopupStack.Size > g.BeginPopupStack.Size) + { + // Don't recycle same menu level in the same frame, first close the other menu and yield for a frame. + OpenPopup(label); + return false; + } + + menu_is_open |= want_open; + if (want_open) + OpenPopup(label); + + if (menu_is_open) + { + SetNextWindowPos(popup_pos, ImGuiCond_Always); // Note: this is super misleading! The value will serve as reference for FindBestWindowPosForPopup(), not actual pos. + menu_is_open = BeginPopupEx(id, flags); // menu_is_open can be 'false' when the popup is completely clipped (e.g. zero size display) + } + else + { + g.NextWindowData.ClearFlags(); // We behave like Begin() and need to consume those values + } + + return menu_is_open; +} + +void ImGui::EndMenu() +{ + // Nav: When a left move request _within our child menu_ failed, close ourselves (the _parent_ menu). + // A menu doesn't close itself because EndMenuBar() wants the catch the last Left<>Right inputs. + // However, it means that with the current code, a BeginMenu() from outside another menu or a menu-bar won't be closable with the Left direction. + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + if (g.NavWindow && g.NavWindow->ParentWindow == window && g.NavMoveDir == ImGuiDir_Left && NavMoveRequestButNoResultYet() && window->DC.LayoutType == ImGuiLayoutType_Vertical) + { + ClosePopupToLevel(g.BeginPopupStack.Size, true); + NavMoveRequestCancel(); + } + + EndPopup(); +} + +bool ImGui::MenuItemEx(const char* label, const char* icon, const char* shortcut, bool selected, bool enabled) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + if (window->SkipItems) + return false; + + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style; + ImVec2 pos = window->DC.CursorPos; + ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true); + + // We've been using the equivalent of ImGuiSelectableFlags_SetNavIdOnHover on all Selectable() since early Nav system days (commit 43ee5d73), + // but I am unsure whether this should be kept at all. For now moved it to be an opt-in feature used by menus only. + bool pressed; + PushID(label); + if (!enabled) + BeginDisabled(true); + const ImGuiSelectableFlags flags = ImGuiSelectableFlags_SelectOnRelease | ImGuiSelectableFlags_SetNavIdOnHover; + const ImGuiMenuColumns* offsets = &window->DC.MenuColumns; + if (window->DC.LayoutType == ImGuiLayoutType_Horizontal) + { + // Mimic the exact layout spacing of BeginMenu() to allow MenuItem() inside a menu bar, which is a little misleading but may be useful + // Note that in this situation: we don't render the shortcut, we render a highlight instead of the selected tick mark. + float w = label_size.x; + window->DC.CursorPos.x += IM_FLOOR(style.ItemSpacing.x * 0.5f); + PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_ItemSpacing, ImVec2(style.ItemSpacing.x * 2.0f, style.ItemSpacing.y)); + pressed = Selectable("", selected, flags, ImVec2(w, 0.0f)); + PopStyleVar(); + RenderText(pos + ImVec2(offsets->OffsetLabel, 0.0f), label); + window->DC.CursorPos.x += IM_FLOOR(style.ItemSpacing.x * (-1.0f + 0.5f)); // -1 spacing to compensate the spacing added when Selectable() did a SameLine(). It would also work to call SameLine() ourselves after the PopStyleVar(). + } + else + { + // Menu item inside a vertical menu + // (In a typical menu window where all items are BeginMenu() or MenuItem() calls, extra_w will always be 0.0f. + // Only when they are other items sticking out we're going to add spacing, yet only register minimum width into the layout system. + float icon_w = (icon && icon[0]) ? CalcTextSize(icon, NULL).x : 0.0f; + float shortcut_w = (shortcut && shortcut[0]) ? CalcTextSize(shortcut, NULL).x : 0.0f; + float checkmark_w = IM_FLOOR(g.FontSize * 1.20f); + float min_w = window->DC.MenuColumns.DeclColumns(icon_w, label_size.x, shortcut_w, checkmark_w); // Feedback for next frame + float stretch_w = ImMax(0.0f, GetContentRegionAvail().x - min_w); + pressed = Selectable("", false, flags | ImGuiSelectableFlags_SpanAvailWidth, ImVec2(min_w, 0.0f)); + RenderText(pos + ImVec2(offsets->OffsetLabel, 0.0f), label); + if (icon_w > 0.0f) + RenderText(pos + ImVec2(offsets->OffsetIcon, 0.0f), icon); + if (shortcut_w > 0.0f) + { + PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_Text, style.Colors[ImGuiCol_TextDisabled]); + RenderText(pos + ImVec2(offsets->OffsetShortcut + stretch_w, 0.0f), shortcut, NULL, false); + PopStyleColor(); + } + if (selected) + RenderCheckMark(window->DrawList, pos + ImVec2(offsets->OffsetMark + stretch_w + g.FontSize * 0.40f, g.FontSize * 0.134f * 0.5f), GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text), g.FontSize * 0.866f); + } + IMGUI_TEST_ENGINE_ITEM_INFO(g.LastItemData.ID, label, g.LastItemData.StatusFlags | ImGuiItemStatusFlags_Checkable | (selected ? ImGuiItemStatusFlags_Checked : 0)); + if (!enabled) + EndDisabled(); + PopID(); + + return pressed; +} + +bool ImGui::MenuItem(const char* label, const char* shortcut, bool selected, bool enabled) +{ + return MenuItemEx(label, NULL, shortcut, selected, enabled); +} + +bool ImGui::MenuItem(const char* label, const char* shortcut, bool* p_selected, bool enabled) +{ + if (MenuItemEx(label, NULL, shortcut, p_selected ? *p_selected : false, enabled)) + { + if (p_selected) + *p_selected = !*p_selected; + return true; + } + return false; +} + +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Widgets: BeginTabBar, EndTabBar, etc. +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// - BeginTabBar() +// - BeginTabBarEx() [Internal] +// - EndTabBar() +// - TabBarLayout() [Internal] +// - TabBarCalcTabID() [Internal] +// - TabBarCalcMaxTabWidth() [Internal] +// - TabBarFindTabById() [Internal] +// - TabBarRemoveTab() [Internal] +// - TabBarCloseTab() [Internal] +// - TabBarScrollClamp() [Internal] +// - TabBarScrollToTab() [Internal] +// - TabBarQueueChangeTabOrder() [Internal] +// - TabBarScrollingButtons() [Internal] +// - TabBarTabListPopupButton() [Internal] +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +struct ImGuiTabBarSection +{ + int TabCount; // Number of tabs in this section. + float Width; // Sum of width of tabs in this section (after shrinking down) + float Spacing; // Horizontal spacing at the end of the section. + + ImGuiTabBarSection() { memset(this, 0, sizeof(*this)); } +}; + +namespace ImGui +{ + static void TabBarLayout(ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar); + static ImU32 TabBarCalcTabID(ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar, const char* label); + static float TabBarCalcMaxTabWidth(); + static float TabBarScrollClamp(ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar, float scrolling); + static void TabBarScrollToTab(ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar, ImGuiID tab_id, ImGuiTabBarSection* sections); + static ImGuiTabItem* TabBarScrollingButtons(ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar); + static ImGuiTabItem* TabBarTabListPopupButton(ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar); +} + +ImGuiTabBar::ImGuiTabBar() +{ + memset(this, 0, sizeof(*this)); + CurrFrameVisible = PrevFrameVisible = -1; + LastTabItemIdx = -1; +} + +static inline int TabItemGetSectionIdx(const ImGuiTabItem* tab) +{ + return (tab->Flags & ImGuiTabItemFlags_Leading) ? 0 : (tab->Flags & ImGuiTabItemFlags_Trailing) ? 2 : 1; +} + +static int IMGUI_CDECL TabItemComparerBySection(const void* lhs, const void* rhs) +{ + const ImGuiTabItem* a = (const ImGuiTabItem*)lhs; + const ImGuiTabItem* b = (const ImGuiTabItem*)rhs; + const int a_section = TabItemGetSectionIdx(a); + const int b_section = TabItemGetSectionIdx(b); + if (a_section != b_section) + return a_section - b_section; + return (int)(a->IndexDuringLayout - b->IndexDuringLayout); +} + +static int IMGUI_CDECL TabItemComparerByBeginOrder(const void* lhs, const void* rhs) +{ + const ImGuiTabItem* a = (const ImGuiTabItem*)lhs; + const ImGuiTabItem* b = (const ImGuiTabItem*)rhs; + return (int)(a->BeginOrder - b->BeginOrder); +} + +static ImGuiTabBar* GetTabBarFromTabBarRef(const ImGuiPtrOrIndex& ref) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + return ref.Ptr ? (ImGuiTabBar*)ref.Ptr : g.TabBars.GetByIndex(ref.Index); +} + +static ImGuiPtrOrIndex GetTabBarRefFromTabBar(ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + if (g.TabBars.Contains(tab_bar)) + return ImGuiPtrOrIndex(g.TabBars.GetIndex(tab_bar)); + return ImGuiPtrOrIndex(tab_bar); +} + +bool ImGui::BeginTabBar(const char* str_id, ImGuiTabBarFlags flags) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + if (window->SkipItems) + return false; + + ImGuiID id = window->GetID(str_id); + ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar = g.TabBars.GetOrAddByKey(id); + ImRect tab_bar_bb = ImRect(window->DC.CursorPos.x, window->DC.CursorPos.y, window->WorkRect.Max.x, window->DC.CursorPos.y + g.FontSize + g.Style.FramePadding.y * 2); + tab_bar->ID = id; + return BeginTabBarEx(tab_bar, tab_bar_bb, flags | ImGuiTabBarFlags_IsFocused); +} + +bool ImGui::BeginTabBarEx(ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar, const ImRect& tab_bar_bb, ImGuiTabBarFlags flags) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + if (window->SkipItems) + return false; + + if ((flags & ImGuiTabBarFlags_DockNode) == 0) + PushOverrideID(tab_bar->ID); + + // Add to stack + g.CurrentTabBarStack.push_back(GetTabBarRefFromTabBar(tab_bar)); + g.CurrentTabBar = tab_bar; + + // Append with multiple BeginTabBar()/EndTabBar() pairs. + tab_bar->BackupCursorPos = window->DC.CursorPos; + if (tab_bar->CurrFrameVisible == g.FrameCount) + { + window->DC.CursorPos = ImVec2(tab_bar->BarRect.Min.x, tab_bar->BarRect.Max.y + tab_bar->ItemSpacingY); + tab_bar->BeginCount++; + return true; + } + + // Ensure correct ordering when toggling ImGuiTabBarFlags_Reorderable flag, or when a new tab was added while being not reorderable + if ((flags & ImGuiTabBarFlags_Reorderable) != (tab_bar->Flags & ImGuiTabBarFlags_Reorderable) || (tab_bar->TabsAddedNew && !(flags & ImGuiTabBarFlags_Reorderable))) + if (tab_bar->Tabs.Size > 1) + ImQsort(tab_bar->Tabs.Data, tab_bar->Tabs.Size, sizeof(ImGuiTabItem), TabItemComparerByBeginOrder); + tab_bar->TabsAddedNew = false; + + // Flags + if ((flags & ImGuiTabBarFlags_FittingPolicyMask_) == 0) + flags |= ImGuiTabBarFlags_FittingPolicyDefault_; + + tab_bar->Flags = flags; + tab_bar->BarRect = tab_bar_bb; + tab_bar->WantLayout = true; // Layout will be done on the first call to ItemTab() + tab_bar->PrevFrameVisible = tab_bar->CurrFrameVisible; + tab_bar->CurrFrameVisible = g.FrameCount; + tab_bar->PrevTabsContentsHeight = tab_bar->CurrTabsContentsHeight; + tab_bar->CurrTabsContentsHeight = 0.0f; + tab_bar->ItemSpacingY = g.Style.ItemSpacing.y; + tab_bar->FramePadding = g.Style.FramePadding; + tab_bar->TabsActiveCount = 0; + tab_bar->BeginCount = 1; + + // Set cursor pos in a way which only be used in the off-chance the user erroneously submits item before BeginTabItem(): items will overlap + window->DC.CursorPos = ImVec2(tab_bar->BarRect.Min.x, tab_bar->BarRect.Max.y + tab_bar->ItemSpacingY); + + // Draw separator + const ImU32 col = GetColorU32((flags & ImGuiTabBarFlags_IsFocused) ? ImGuiCol_TabActive : ImGuiCol_TabUnfocusedActive); + const float y = tab_bar->BarRect.Max.y - 1.0f; + { + const float separator_min_x = tab_bar->BarRect.Min.x - IM_FLOOR(window->WindowPadding.x * 0.5f); + const float separator_max_x = tab_bar->BarRect.Max.x + IM_FLOOR(window->WindowPadding.x * 0.5f); + window->DrawList->AddLine(ImVec2(separator_min_x, y), ImVec2(separator_max_x, y), col, 1.0f); + } + return true; +} + +void ImGui::EndTabBar() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + if (window->SkipItems) + return; + + ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar = g.CurrentTabBar; + if (tab_bar == NULL) + { + IM_ASSERT_USER_ERROR(tab_bar != NULL, "Mismatched BeginTabBar()/EndTabBar()!"); + return; + } + + // Fallback in case no TabItem have been submitted + if (tab_bar->WantLayout) + TabBarLayout(tab_bar); + + // Restore the last visible height if no tab is visible, this reduce vertical flicker/movement when a tabs gets removed without calling SetTabItemClosed(). + const bool tab_bar_appearing = (tab_bar->PrevFrameVisible + 1 < g.FrameCount); + if (tab_bar->VisibleTabWasSubmitted || tab_bar->VisibleTabId == 0 || tab_bar_appearing) + { + tab_bar->CurrTabsContentsHeight = ImMax(window->DC.CursorPos.y - tab_bar->BarRect.Max.y, tab_bar->CurrTabsContentsHeight); + window->DC.CursorPos.y = tab_bar->BarRect.Max.y + tab_bar->CurrTabsContentsHeight; + } + else + { + window->DC.CursorPos.y = tab_bar->BarRect.Max.y + tab_bar->PrevTabsContentsHeight; + } + if (tab_bar->BeginCount > 1) + window->DC.CursorPos = tab_bar->BackupCursorPos; + + if ((tab_bar->Flags & ImGuiTabBarFlags_DockNode) == 0) + PopID(); + + g.CurrentTabBarStack.pop_back(); + g.CurrentTabBar = g.CurrentTabBarStack.empty() ? NULL : GetTabBarFromTabBarRef(g.CurrentTabBarStack.back()); +} + +// This is called only once a frame before by the first call to ItemTab() +// The reason we're not calling it in BeginTabBar() is to leave a chance to the user to call the SetTabItemClosed() functions. +static void ImGui::TabBarLayout(ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + tab_bar->WantLayout = false; + + // Garbage collect by compacting list + // Detect if we need to sort out tab list (e.g. in rare case where a tab changed section) + int tab_dst_n = 0; + bool need_sort_by_section = false; + ImGuiTabBarSection sections[3]; // Layout sections: Leading, Central, Trailing + for (int tab_src_n = 0; tab_src_n < tab_bar->Tabs.Size; tab_src_n++) + { + ImGuiTabItem* tab = &tab_bar->Tabs[tab_src_n]; + if (tab->LastFrameVisible < tab_bar->PrevFrameVisible || tab->WantClose) + { + // Remove tab + if (tab_bar->VisibleTabId == tab->ID) { tab_bar->VisibleTabId = 0; } + if (tab_bar->SelectedTabId == tab->ID) { tab_bar->SelectedTabId = 0; } + if (tab_bar->NextSelectedTabId == tab->ID) { tab_bar->NextSelectedTabId = 0; } + continue; + } + if (tab_dst_n != tab_src_n) + tab_bar->Tabs[tab_dst_n] = tab_bar->Tabs[tab_src_n]; + + tab = &tab_bar->Tabs[tab_dst_n]; + tab->IndexDuringLayout = (ImS16)tab_dst_n; + + // We will need sorting if tabs have changed section (e.g. moved from one of Leading/Central/Trailing to another) + int curr_tab_section_n = TabItemGetSectionIdx(tab); + if (tab_dst_n > 0) + { + ImGuiTabItem* prev_tab = &tab_bar->Tabs[tab_dst_n - 1]; + int prev_tab_section_n = TabItemGetSectionIdx(prev_tab); + if (curr_tab_section_n == 0 && prev_tab_section_n != 0) + need_sort_by_section = true; + if (prev_tab_section_n == 2 && curr_tab_section_n != 2) + need_sort_by_section = true; + } + + sections[curr_tab_section_n].TabCount++; + tab_dst_n++; + } + if (tab_bar->Tabs.Size != tab_dst_n) + tab_bar->Tabs.resize(tab_dst_n); + + if (need_sort_by_section) + ImQsort(tab_bar->Tabs.Data, tab_bar->Tabs.Size, sizeof(ImGuiTabItem), TabItemComparerBySection); + + // Calculate spacing between sections + sections[0].Spacing = sections[0].TabCount > 0 && (sections[1].TabCount + sections[2].TabCount) > 0 ? g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x : 0.0f; + sections[1].Spacing = sections[1].TabCount > 0 && sections[2].TabCount > 0 ? g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x : 0.0f; + + // Setup next selected tab + ImGuiID scroll_to_tab_id = 0; + if (tab_bar->NextSelectedTabId) + { + tab_bar->SelectedTabId = tab_bar->NextSelectedTabId; + tab_bar->NextSelectedTabId = 0; + scroll_to_tab_id = tab_bar->SelectedTabId; + } + + // Process order change request (we could probably process it when requested but it's just saner to do it in a single spot). + if (tab_bar->ReorderRequestTabId != 0) + { + if (TabBarProcessReorder(tab_bar)) + if (tab_bar->ReorderRequestTabId == tab_bar->SelectedTabId) + scroll_to_tab_id = tab_bar->ReorderRequestTabId; + tab_bar->ReorderRequestTabId = 0; + } + + // Tab List Popup (will alter tab_bar->BarRect and therefore the available width!) + const bool tab_list_popup_button = (tab_bar->Flags & ImGuiTabBarFlags_TabListPopupButton) != 0; + if (tab_list_popup_button) + if (ImGuiTabItem* tab_to_select = TabBarTabListPopupButton(tab_bar)) // NB: Will alter BarRect.Min.x! + scroll_to_tab_id = tab_bar->SelectedTabId = tab_to_select->ID; + + // Leading/Trailing tabs will be shrink only if central one aren't visible anymore, so layout the shrink data as: leading, trailing, central + // (whereas our tabs are stored as: leading, central, trailing) + int shrink_buffer_indexes[3] = { 0, sections[0].TabCount + sections[2].TabCount, sections[0].TabCount }; + g.ShrinkWidthBuffer.resize(tab_bar->Tabs.Size); + + // Compute ideal tabs widths + store them into shrink buffer + ImGuiTabItem* most_recently_selected_tab = NULL; + int curr_section_n = -1; + bool found_selected_tab_id = false; + for (int tab_n = 0; tab_n < tab_bar->Tabs.Size; tab_n++) + { + ImGuiTabItem* tab = &tab_bar->Tabs[tab_n]; + IM_ASSERT(tab->LastFrameVisible >= tab_bar->PrevFrameVisible); + + if ((most_recently_selected_tab == NULL || most_recently_selected_tab->LastFrameSelected < tab->LastFrameSelected) && !(tab->Flags & ImGuiTabItemFlags_Button)) + most_recently_selected_tab = tab; + if (tab->ID == tab_bar->SelectedTabId) + found_selected_tab_id = true; + if (scroll_to_tab_id == 0 && g.NavJustMovedToId == tab->ID) + scroll_to_tab_id = tab->ID; + + // Refresh tab width immediately, otherwise changes of style e.g. style.FramePadding.x would noticeably lag in the tab bar. + // Additionally, when using TabBarAddTab() to manipulate tab bar order we occasionally insert new tabs that don't have a width yet, + // and we cannot wait for the next BeginTabItem() call. We cannot compute this width within TabBarAddTab() because font size depends on the active window. + const char* tab_name = tab_bar->GetTabName(tab); + const bool has_close_button = (tab->Flags & ImGuiTabItemFlags_NoCloseButton) ? false : true; + tab->ContentWidth = TabItemCalcSize(tab_name, has_close_button).x; + + int section_n = TabItemGetSectionIdx(tab); + ImGuiTabBarSection* section = §ions[section_n]; + section->Width += tab->ContentWidth + (section_n == curr_section_n ? g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x : 0.0f); + curr_section_n = section_n; + + // Store data so we can build an array sorted by width if we need to shrink tabs down + IM_MSVC_WARNING_SUPPRESS(6385); + int shrink_buffer_index = shrink_buffer_indexes[section_n]++; + g.ShrinkWidthBuffer[shrink_buffer_index].Index = tab_n; + g.ShrinkWidthBuffer[shrink_buffer_index].Width = tab->ContentWidth; + + IM_ASSERT(tab->ContentWidth > 0.0f); + tab->Width = tab->ContentWidth; + } + + // Compute total ideal width (used for e.g. auto-resizing a window) + tab_bar->WidthAllTabsIdeal = 0.0f; + for (int section_n = 0; section_n < 3; section_n++) + tab_bar->WidthAllTabsIdeal += sections[section_n].Width + sections[section_n].Spacing; + + // Horizontal scrolling buttons + // (note that TabBarScrollButtons() will alter BarRect.Max.x) + if ((tab_bar->WidthAllTabsIdeal > tab_bar->BarRect.GetWidth() && tab_bar->Tabs.Size > 1) && !(tab_bar->Flags & ImGuiTabBarFlags_NoTabListScrollingButtons) && (tab_bar->Flags & ImGuiTabBarFlags_FittingPolicyScroll)) + if (ImGuiTabItem* scroll_and_select_tab = TabBarScrollingButtons(tab_bar)) + { + scroll_to_tab_id = scroll_and_select_tab->ID; + if ((scroll_and_select_tab->Flags & ImGuiTabItemFlags_Button) == 0) + tab_bar->SelectedTabId = scroll_to_tab_id; + } + + // Shrink widths if full tabs don't fit in their allocated space + float section_0_w = sections[0].Width + sections[0].Spacing; + float section_1_w = sections[1].Width + sections[1].Spacing; + float section_2_w = sections[2].Width + sections[2].Spacing; + bool central_section_is_visible = (section_0_w + section_2_w) < tab_bar->BarRect.GetWidth(); + float width_excess; + if (central_section_is_visible) + width_excess = ImMax(section_1_w - (tab_bar->BarRect.GetWidth() - section_0_w - section_2_w), 0.0f); // Excess used to shrink central section + else + width_excess = (section_0_w + section_2_w) - tab_bar->BarRect.GetWidth(); // Excess used to shrink leading/trailing section + + // With ImGuiTabBarFlags_FittingPolicyScroll policy, we will only shrink leading/trailing if the central section is not visible anymore + if (width_excess > 0.0f && ((tab_bar->Flags & ImGuiTabBarFlags_FittingPolicyResizeDown) || !central_section_is_visible)) + { + int shrink_data_count = (central_section_is_visible ? sections[1].TabCount : sections[0].TabCount + sections[2].TabCount); + int shrink_data_offset = (central_section_is_visible ? sections[0].TabCount + sections[2].TabCount : 0); + ShrinkWidths(g.ShrinkWidthBuffer.Data + shrink_data_offset, shrink_data_count, width_excess); + + // Apply shrunk values into tabs and sections + for (int tab_n = shrink_data_offset; tab_n < shrink_data_offset + shrink_data_count; tab_n++) + { + ImGuiTabItem* tab = &tab_bar->Tabs[g.ShrinkWidthBuffer[tab_n].Index]; + float shrinked_width = IM_FLOOR(g.ShrinkWidthBuffer[tab_n].Width); + if (shrinked_width < 0.0f) + continue; + + int section_n = TabItemGetSectionIdx(tab); + sections[section_n].Width -= (tab->Width - shrinked_width); + tab->Width = shrinked_width; + } + } + + // Layout all active tabs + int section_tab_index = 0; + float tab_offset = 0.0f; + tab_bar->WidthAllTabs = 0.0f; + for (int section_n = 0; section_n < 3; section_n++) + { + ImGuiTabBarSection* section = §ions[section_n]; + if (section_n == 2) + tab_offset = ImMin(ImMax(0.0f, tab_bar->BarRect.GetWidth() - section->Width), tab_offset); + + for (int tab_n = 0; tab_n < section->TabCount; tab_n++) + { + ImGuiTabItem* tab = &tab_bar->Tabs[section_tab_index + tab_n]; + tab->Offset = tab_offset; + tab_offset += tab->Width + (tab_n < section->TabCount - 1 ? g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x : 0.0f); + } + tab_bar->WidthAllTabs += ImMax(section->Width + section->Spacing, 0.0f); + tab_offset += section->Spacing; + section_tab_index += section->TabCount; + } + + // If we have lost the selected tab, select the next most recently active one + if (found_selected_tab_id == false) + tab_bar->SelectedTabId = 0; + if (tab_bar->SelectedTabId == 0 && tab_bar->NextSelectedTabId == 0 && most_recently_selected_tab != NULL) + scroll_to_tab_id = tab_bar->SelectedTabId = most_recently_selected_tab->ID; + + // Lock in visible tab + tab_bar->VisibleTabId = tab_bar->SelectedTabId; + tab_bar->VisibleTabWasSubmitted = false; + + // Update scrolling + if (scroll_to_tab_id != 0) + TabBarScrollToTab(tab_bar, scroll_to_tab_id, sections); + tab_bar->ScrollingAnim = TabBarScrollClamp(tab_bar, tab_bar->ScrollingAnim); + tab_bar->ScrollingTarget = TabBarScrollClamp(tab_bar, tab_bar->ScrollingTarget); + if (tab_bar->ScrollingAnim != tab_bar->ScrollingTarget) + { + // Scrolling speed adjust itself so we can always reach our target in 1/3 seconds. + // Teleport if we are aiming far off the visible line + tab_bar->ScrollingSpeed = ImMax(tab_bar->ScrollingSpeed, 70.0f * g.FontSize); + tab_bar->ScrollingSpeed = ImMax(tab_bar->ScrollingSpeed, ImFabs(tab_bar->ScrollingTarget - tab_bar->ScrollingAnim) / 0.3f); + const bool teleport = (tab_bar->PrevFrameVisible + 1 < g.FrameCount) || (tab_bar->ScrollingTargetDistToVisibility > 10.0f * g.FontSize); + tab_bar->ScrollingAnim = teleport ? tab_bar->ScrollingTarget : ImLinearSweep(tab_bar->ScrollingAnim, tab_bar->ScrollingTarget, g.IO.DeltaTime * tab_bar->ScrollingSpeed); + } + else + { + tab_bar->ScrollingSpeed = 0.0f; + } + tab_bar->ScrollingRectMinX = tab_bar->BarRect.Min.x + sections[0].Width + sections[0].Spacing; + tab_bar->ScrollingRectMaxX = tab_bar->BarRect.Max.x - sections[2].Width - sections[1].Spacing; + + // Clear name buffers + if ((tab_bar->Flags & ImGuiTabBarFlags_DockNode) == 0) + tab_bar->TabsNames.Buf.resize(0); + + // Actual layout in host window (we don't do it in BeginTabBar() so as not to waste an extra frame) + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + window->DC.CursorPos = tab_bar->BarRect.Min; + ItemSize(ImVec2(tab_bar->WidthAllTabs, tab_bar->BarRect.GetHeight()), tab_bar->FramePadding.y); + window->DC.IdealMaxPos.x = ImMax(window->DC.IdealMaxPos.x, tab_bar->BarRect.Min.x + tab_bar->WidthAllTabsIdeal); +} + +// Dockables uses Name/ID in the global namespace. Non-dockable items use the ID stack. +static ImU32 ImGui::TabBarCalcTabID(ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar, const char* label) +{ + if (tab_bar->Flags & ImGuiTabBarFlags_DockNode) + { + ImGuiID id = ImHashStr(label); + KeepAliveID(id); + return id; + } + else + { + ImGuiWindow* window = GImGui->CurrentWindow; + return window->GetID(label); + } +} + +static float ImGui::TabBarCalcMaxTabWidth() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + return g.FontSize * 20.0f; +} + +ImGuiTabItem* ImGui::TabBarFindTabByID(ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar, ImGuiID tab_id) +{ + if (tab_id != 0) + for (int n = 0; n < tab_bar->Tabs.Size; n++) + if (tab_bar->Tabs[n].ID == tab_id) + return &tab_bar->Tabs[n]; + return NULL; +} + +// The *TabId fields be already set by the docking system _before_ the actual TabItem was created, so we clear them regardless. +void ImGui::TabBarRemoveTab(ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar, ImGuiID tab_id) +{ + if (ImGuiTabItem* tab = TabBarFindTabByID(tab_bar, tab_id)) + tab_bar->Tabs.erase(tab); + if (tab_bar->VisibleTabId == tab_id) { tab_bar->VisibleTabId = 0; } + if (tab_bar->SelectedTabId == tab_id) { tab_bar->SelectedTabId = 0; } + if (tab_bar->NextSelectedTabId == tab_id) { tab_bar->NextSelectedTabId = 0; } +} + +// Called on manual closure attempt +void ImGui::TabBarCloseTab(ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar, ImGuiTabItem* tab) +{ + IM_ASSERT(!(tab->Flags & ImGuiTabItemFlags_Button)); + if (!(tab->Flags & ImGuiTabItemFlags_UnsavedDocument)) + { + // This will remove a frame of lag for selecting another tab on closure. + // However we don't run it in the case where the 'Unsaved' flag is set, so user gets a chance to fully undo the closure + tab->WantClose = true; + if (tab_bar->VisibleTabId == tab->ID) + { + tab->LastFrameVisible = -1; + tab_bar->SelectedTabId = tab_bar->NextSelectedTabId = 0; + } + } + else + { + // Actually select before expecting closure attempt (on an UnsavedDocument tab user is expect to e.g. show a popup) + if (tab_bar->VisibleTabId != tab->ID) + tab_bar->NextSelectedTabId = tab->ID; + } +} + +static float ImGui::TabBarScrollClamp(ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar, float scrolling) +{ + scrolling = ImMin(scrolling, tab_bar->WidthAllTabs - tab_bar->BarRect.GetWidth()); + return ImMax(scrolling, 0.0f); +} + +// Note: we may scroll to tab that are not selected! e.g. using keyboard arrow keys +static void ImGui::TabBarScrollToTab(ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar, ImGuiID tab_id, ImGuiTabBarSection* sections) +{ + ImGuiTabItem* tab = TabBarFindTabByID(tab_bar, tab_id); + if (tab == NULL) + return; + if (tab->Flags & ImGuiTabItemFlags_SectionMask_) + return; + + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + float margin = g.FontSize * 1.0f; // When to scroll to make Tab N+1 visible always make a bit of N visible to suggest more scrolling area (since we don't have a scrollbar) + int order = tab_bar->GetTabOrder(tab); + + // Scrolling happens only in the central section (leading/trailing sections are not scrolling) + // FIXME: This is all confusing. + float scrollable_width = tab_bar->BarRect.GetWidth() - sections[0].Width - sections[2].Width - sections[1].Spacing; + + // We make all tabs positions all relative Sections[0].Width to make code simpler + float tab_x1 = tab->Offset - sections[0].Width + (order > sections[0].TabCount - 1 ? -margin : 0.0f); + float tab_x2 = tab->Offset - sections[0].Width + tab->Width + (order + 1 < tab_bar->Tabs.Size - sections[2].TabCount ? margin : 1.0f); + tab_bar->ScrollingTargetDistToVisibility = 0.0f; + if (tab_bar->ScrollingTarget > tab_x1 || (tab_x2 - tab_x1 >= scrollable_width)) + { + // Scroll to the left + tab_bar->ScrollingTargetDistToVisibility = ImMax(tab_bar->ScrollingAnim - tab_x2, 0.0f); + tab_bar->ScrollingTarget = tab_x1; + } + else if (tab_bar->ScrollingTarget < tab_x2 - scrollable_width) + { + // Scroll to the right + tab_bar->ScrollingTargetDistToVisibility = ImMax((tab_x1 - scrollable_width) - tab_bar->ScrollingAnim, 0.0f); + tab_bar->ScrollingTarget = tab_x2 - scrollable_width; + } +} + +void ImGui::TabBarQueueReorder(ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar, const ImGuiTabItem* tab, int offset) +{ + IM_ASSERT(offset != 0); + IM_ASSERT(tab_bar->ReorderRequestTabId == 0); + tab_bar->ReorderRequestTabId = tab->ID; + tab_bar->ReorderRequestOffset = (ImS16)offset; +} + +void ImGui::TabBarQueueReorderFromMousePos(ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar, const ImGuiTabItem* src_tab, ImVec2 mouse_pos) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + IM_ASSERT(tab_bar->ReorderRequestTabId == 0); + if ((tab_bar->Flags & ImGuiTabBarFlags_Reorderable) == 0) + return; + + const bool is_central_section = (src_tab->Flags & ImGuiTabItemFlags_SectionMask_) == 0; + const float bar_offset = tab_bar->BarRect.Min.x - (is_central_section ? tab_bar->ScrollingTarget : 0); + + // Count number of contiguous tabs we are crossing over + const int dir = (bar_offset + src_tab->Offset) > mouse_pos.x ? -1 : +1; + const int src_idx = tab_bar->Tabs.index_from_ptr(src_tab); + int dst_idx = src_idx; + for (int i = src_idx; i >= 0 && i < tab_bar->Tabs.Size; i += dir) + { + // Reordered tabs must share the same section + const ImGuiTabItem* dst_tab = &tab_bar->Tabs[i]; + if (dst_tab->Flags & ImGuiTabItemFlags_NoReorder) + break; + if ((dst_tab->Flags & ImGuiTabItemFlags_SectionMask_) != (src_tab->Flags & ImGuiTabItemFlags_SectionMask_)) + break; + dst_idx = i; + + // Include spacing after tab, so when mouse cursor is between tabs we would not continue checking further tabs that are not hovered. + const float x1 = bar_offset + dst_tab->Offset - g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x; + const float x2 = bar_offset + dst_tab->Offset + dst_tab->Width + g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x; + //GetForegroundDrawList()->AddRect(ImVec2(x1, tab_bar->BarRect.Min.y), ImVec2(x2, tab_bar->BarRect.Max.y), IM_COL32(255, 0, 0, 255)); + if ((dir < 0 && mouse_pos.x > x1) || (dir > 0 && mouse_pos.x < x2)) + break; + } + + if (dst_idx != src_idx) + TabBarQueueReorder(tab_bar, src_tab, dst_idx - src_idx); +} + +bool ImGui::TabBarProcessReorder(ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar) +{ + ImGuiTabItem* tab1 = TabBarFindTabByID(tab_bar, tab_bar->ReorderRequestTabId); + if (tab1 == NULL || (tab1->Flags & ImGuiTabItemFlags_NoReorder)) + return false; + + //IM_ASSERT(tab_bar->Flags & ImGuiTabBarFlags_Reorderable); // <- this may happen when using debug tools + int tab2_order = tab_bar->GetTabOrder(tab1) + tab_bar->ReorderRequestOffset; + if (tab2_order < 0 || tab2_order >= tab_bar->Tabs.Size) + return false; + + // Reordered tabs must share the same section + // (Note: TabBarQueueReorderFromMousePos() also has a similar test but since we allow direct calls to TabBarQueueReorder() we do it here too) + ImGuiTabItem* tab2 = &tab_bar->Tabs[tab2_order]; + if (tab2->Flags & ImGuiTabItemFlags_NoReorder) + return false; + if ((tab1->Flags & ImGuiTabItemFlags_SectionMask_) != (tab2->Flags & ImGuiTabItemFlags_SectionMask_)) + return false; + + ImGuiTabItem item_tmp = *tab1; + ImGuiTabItem* src_tab = (tab_bar->ReorderRequestOffset > 0) ? tab1 + 1 : tab2; + ImGuiTabItem* dst_tab = (tab_bar->ReorderRequestOffset > 0) ? tab1 : tab2 + 1; + const int move_count = (tab_bar->ReorderRequestOffset > 0) ? tab_bar->ReorderRequestOffset : -tab_bar->ReorderRequestOffset; + memmove(dst_tab, src_tab, move_count * sizeof(ImGuiTabItem)); + *tab2 = item_tmp; + + if (tab_bar->Flags & ImGuiTabBarFlags_SaveSettings) + MarkIniSettingsDirty(); + return true; +} + +static ImGuiTabItem* ImGui::TabBarScrollingButtons(ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + + const ImVec2 arrow_button_size(g.FontSize - 2.0f, g.FontSize + g.Style.FramePadding.y * 2.0f); + const float scrolling_buttons_width = arrow_button_size.x * 2.0f; + + const ImVec2 backup_cursor_pos = window->DC.CursorPos; + //window->DrawList->AddRect(ImVec2(tab_bar->BarRect.Max.x - scrolling_buttons_width, tab_bar->BarRect.Min.y), ImVec2(tab_bar->BarRect.Max.x, tab_bar->BarRect.Max.y), IM_COL32(255,0,0,255)); + + int select_dir = 0; + ImVec4 arrow_col = g.Style.Colors[ImGuiCol_Text]; + arrow_col.w *= 0.5f; + + PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_Text, arrow_col); + PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_Button, ImVec4(0, 0, 0, 0)); + const float backup_repeat_delay = g.IO.KeyRepeatDelay; + const float backup_repeat_rate = g.IO.KeyRepeatRate; + g.IO.KeyRepeatDelay = 0.250f; + g.IO.KeyRepeatRate = 0.200f; + float x = ImMax(tab_bar->BarRect.Min.x, tab_bar->BarRect.Max.x - scrolling_buttons_width); + window->DC.CursorPos = ImVec2(x, tab_bar->BarRect.Min.y); + if (ArrowButtonEx("##<", ImGuiDir_Left, arrow_button_size, ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClick | ImGuiButtonFlags_Repeat)) + select_dir = -1; + window->DC.CursorPos = ImVec2(x + arrow_button_size.x, tab_bar->BarRect.Min.y); + if (ArrowButtonEx("##>", ImGuiDir_Right, arrow_button_size, ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClick | ImGuiButtonFlags_Repeat)) + select_dir = +1; + PopStyleColor(2); + g.IO.KeyRepeatRate = backup_repeat_rate; + g.IO.KeyRepeatDelay = backup_repeat_delay; + + ImGuiTabItem* tab_to_scroll_to = NULL; + if (select_dir != 0) + if (ImGuiTabItem* tab_item = TabBarFindTabByID(tab_bar, tab_bar->SelectedTabId)) + { + int selected_order = tab_bar->GetTabOrder(tab_item); + int target_order = selected_order + select_dir; + + // Skip tab item buttons until another tab item is found or end is reached + while (tab_to_scroll_to == NULL) + { + // If we are at the end of the list, still scroll to make our tab visible + tab_to_scroll_to = &tab_bar->Tabs[(target_order >= 0 && target_order < tab_bar->Tabs.Size) ? target_order : selected_order]; + + // Cross through buttons + // (even if first/last item is a button, return it so we can update the scroll) + if (tab_to_scroll_to->Flags & ImGuiTabItemFlags_Button) + { + target_order += select_dir; + selected_order += select_dir; + tab_to_scroll_to = (target_order < 0 || target_order >= tab_bar->Tabs.Size) ? tab_to_scroll_to : NULL; + } + } + } + window->DC.CursorPos = backup_cursor_pos; + tab_bar->BarRect.Max.x -= scrolling_buttons_width + 1.0f; + + return tab_to_scroll_to; +} + +static ImGuiTabItem* ImGui::TabBarTabListPopupButton(ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + + // We use g.Style.FramePadding.y to match the square ArrowButton size + const float tab_list_popup_button_width = g.FontSize + g.Style.FramePadding.y; + const ImVec2 backup_cursor_pos = window->DC.CursorPos; + window->DC.CursorPos = ImVec2(tab_bar->BarRect.Min.x - g.Style.FramePadding.y, tab_bar->BarRect.Min.y); + tab_bar->BarRect.Min.x += tab_list_popup_button_width; + + ImVec4 arrow_col = g.Style.Colors[ImGuiCol_Text]; + arrow_col.w *= 0.5f; + PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_Text, arrow_col); + PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_Button, ImVec4(0, 0, 0, 0)); + bool open = BeginCombo("##v", NULL, ImGuiComboFlags_NoPreview | ImGuiComboFlags_HeightLargest); + PopStyleColor(2); + + ImGuiTabItem* tab_to_select = NULL; + if (open) + { + for (int tab_n = 0; tab_n < tab_bar->Tabs.Size; tab_n++) + { + ImGuiTabItem* tab = &tab_bar->Tabs[tab_n]; + if (tab->Flags & ImGuiTabItemFlags_Button) + continue; + + const char* tab_name = tab_bar->GetTabName(tab); + if (Selectable(tab_name, tab_bar->SelectedTabId == tab->ID)) + tab_to_select = tab; + } + EndCombo(); + } + + window->DC.CursorPos = backup_cursor_pos; + return tab_to_select; +} + +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Widgets: BeginTabItem, EndTabItem, etc. +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// - BeginTabItem() +// - EndTabItem() +// - TabItemButton() +// - TabItemEx() [Internal] +// - SetTabItemClosed() +// - TabItemCalcSize() [Internal] +// - TabItemBackground() [Internal] +// - TabItemLabelAndCloseButton() [Internal] +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +bool ImGui::BeginTabItem(const char* label, bool* p_open, ImGuiTabItemFlags flags) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + if (window->SkipItems) + return false; + + ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar = g.CurrentTabBar; + if (tab_bar == NULL) + { + IM_ASSERT_USER_ERROR(tab_bar, "Needs to be called between BeginTabBar() and EndTabBar()!"); + return false; + } + IM_ASSERT(!(flags & ImGuiTabItemFlags_Button)); // BeginTabItem() Can't be used with button flags, use TabItemButton() instead! + + bool ret = TabItemEx(tab_bar, label, p_open, flags); + if (ret && !(flags & ImGuiTabItemFlags_NoPushId)) + { + ImGuiTabItem* tab = &tab_bar->Tabs[tab_bar->LastTabItemIdx]; + PushOverrideID(tab->ID); // We already hashed 'label' so push into the ID stack directly instead of doing another hash through PushID(label) + } + return ret; +} + +void ImGui::EndTabItem() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + if (window->SkipItems) + return; + + ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar = g.CurrentTabBar; + if (tab_bar == NULL) + { + IM_ASSERT_USER_ERROR(tab_bar != NULL, "Needs to be called between BeginTabBar() and EndTabBar()!"); + return; + } + IM_ASSERT(tab_bar->LastTabItemIdx >= 0); + ImGuiTabItem* tab = &tab_bar->Tabs[tab_bar->LastTabItemIdx]; + if (!(tab->Flags & ImGuiTabItemFlags_NoPushId)) + PopID(); +} + +bool ImGui::TabItemButton(const char* label, ImGuiTabItemFlags flags) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + if (window->SkipItems) + return false; + + ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar = g.CurrentTabBar; + if (tab_bar == NULL) + { + IM_ASSERT_USER_ERROR(tab_bar != NULL, "Needs to be called between BeginTabBar() and EndTabBar()!"); + return false; + } + return TabItemEx(tab_bar, label, NULL, flags | ImGuiTabItemFlags_Button | ImGuiTabItemFlags_NoReorder); +} + +bool ImGui::TabItemEx(ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar, const char* label, bool* p_open, ImGuiTabItemFlags flags) +{ + // Layout whole tab bar if not already done + if (tab_bar->WantLayout) + TabBarLayout(tab_bar); + + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + if (window->SkipItems) + return false; + + const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style; + const ImGuiID id = TabBarCalcTabID(tab_bar, label); + + // If the user called us with *p_open == false, we early out and don't render. + // We make a call to ItemAdd() so that attempts to use a contextual popup menu with an implicit ID won't use an older ID. + IMGUI_TEST_ENGINE_ITEM_INFO(id, label, g.LastItemData.StatusFlags); + if (p_open && !*p_open) + { + PushItemFlag(ImGuiItemFlags_NoNav | ImGuiItemFlags_NoNavDefaultFocus, true); + ItemAdd(ImRect(), id); + PopItemFlag(); + return false; + } + + IM_ASSERT(!p_open || !(flags & ImGuiTabItemFlags_Button)); + IM_ASSERT((flags & (ImGuiTabItemFlags_Leading | ImGuiTabItemFlags_Trailing)) != (ImGuiTabItemFlags_Leading | ImGuiTabItemFlags_Trailing)); // Can't use both Leading and Trailing + + // Store into ImGuiTabItemFlags_NoCloseButton, also honor ImGuiTabItemFlags_NoCloseButton passed by user (although not documented) + if (flags & ImGuiTabItemFlags_NoCloseButton) + p_open = NULL; + else if (p_open == NULL) + flags |= ImGuiTabItemFlags_NoCloseButton; + + // Calculate tab contents size + ImVec2 size = TabItemCalcSize(label, p_open != NULL); + + // Acquire tab data + ImGuiTabItem* tab = TabBarFindTabByID(tab_bar, id); + bool tab_is_new = false; + if (tab == NULL) + { + tab_bar->Tabs.push_back(ImGuiTabItem()); + tab = &tab_bar->Tabs.back(); + tab->ID = id; + tab->Width = size.x; + tab_bar->TabsAddedNew = true; + tab_is_new = true; + } + tab_bar->LastTabItemIdx = (ImS16)tab_bar->Tabs.index_from_ptr(tab); + tab->ContentWidth = size.x; + tab->BeginOrder = tab_bar->TabsActiveCount++; + + const bool tab_bar_appearing = (tab_bar->PrevFrameVisible + 1 < g.FrameCount); + const bool tab_bar_focused = (tab_bar->Flags & ImGuiTabBarFlags_IsFocused) != 0; + const bool tab_appearing = (tab->LastFrameVisible + 1 < g.FrameCount); + const bool is_tab_button = (flags & ImGuiTabItemFlags_Button) != 0; + tab->LastFrameVisible = g.FrameCount; + tab->Flags = flags; + + // Append name with zero-terminator + tab->NameOffset = (ImS32)tab_bar->TabsNames.size(); + tab_bar->TabsNames.append(label, label + strlen(label) + 1); + + // Update selected tab + if (tab_appearing && (tab_bar->Flags & ImGuiTabBarFlags_AutoSelectNewTabs) && tab_bar->NextSelectedTabId == 0) + if (!tab_bar_appearing || tab_bar->SelectedTabId == 0) + if (!is_tab_button) + tab_bar->NextSelectedTabId = id; // New tabs gets activated + if ((flags & ImGuiTabItemFlags_SetSelected) && (tab_bar->SelectedTabId != id)) // SetSelected can only be passed on explicit tab bar + if (!is_tab_button) + tab_bar->NextSelectedTabId = id; + + // Lock visibility + // (Note: tab_contents_visible != tab_selected... because CTRL+TAB operations may preview some tabs without selecting them!) + bool tab_contents_visible = (tab_bar->VisibleTabId == id); + if (tab_contents_visible) + tab_bar->VisibleTabWasSubmitted = true; + + // On the very first frame of a tab bar we let first tab contents be visible to minimize appearing glitches + if (!tab_contents_visible && tab_bar->SelectedTabId == 0 && tab_bar_appearing) + if (tab_bar->Tabs.Size == 1 && !(tab_bar->Flags & ImGuiTabBarFlags_AutoSelectNewTabs)) + tab_contents_visible = true; + + // Note that tab_is_new is not necessarily the same as tab_appearing! When a tab bar stops being submitted + // and then gets submitted again, the tabs will have 'tab_appearing=true' but 'tab_is_new=false'. + if (tab_appearing && (!tab_bar_appearing || tab_is_new)) + { + PushItemFlag(ImGuiItemFlags_NoNav | ImGuiItemFlags_NoNavDefaultFocus, true); + ItemAdd(ImRect(), id); + PopItemFlag(); + if (is_tab_button) + return false; + return tab_contents_visible; + } + + if (tab_bar->SelectedTabId == id) + tab->LastFrameSelected = g.FrameCount; + + // Backup current layout position + const ImVec2 backup_main_cursor_pos = window->DC.CursorPos; + + // Layout + const bool is_central_section = (tab->Flags & ImGuiTabItemFlags_SectionMask_) == 0; + size.x = tab->Width; + if (is_central_section) + window->DC.CursorPos = tab_bar->BarRect.Min + ImVec2(IM_FLOOR(tab->Offset - tab_bar->ScrollingAnim), 0.0f); + else + window->DC.CursorPos = tab_bar->BarRect.Min + ImVec2(tab->Offset, 0.0f); + ImVec2 pos = window->DC.CursorPos; + ImRect bb(pos, pos + size); + + // We don't have CPU clipping primitives to clip the CloseButton (until it becomes a texture), so need to add an extra draw call (temporary in the case of vertical animation) + const bool want_clip_rect = is_central_section && (bb.Min.x < tab_bar->ScrollingRectMinX || bb.Max.x > tab_bar->ScrollingRectMaxX); + if (want_clip_rect) + PushClipRect(ImVec2(ImMax(bb.Min.x, tab_bar->ScrollingRectMinX), bb.Min.y - 1), ImVec2(tab_bar->ScrollingRectMaxX, bb.Max.y), true); + + ImVec2 backup_cursor_max_pos = window->DC.CursorMaxPos; + ItemSize(bb.GetSize(), style.FramePadding.y); + window->DC.CursorMaxPos = backup_cursor_max_pos; + + if (!ItemAdd(bb, id)) + { + if (want_clip_rect) + PopClipRect(); + window->DC.CursorPos = backup_main_cursor_pos; + return tab_contents_visible; + } + + // Click to Select a tab + ImGuiButtonFlags button_flags = ((is_tab_button ? ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClickRelease : ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClick) | ImGuiButtonFlags_AllowItemOverlap); + if (g.DragDropActive) + button_flags |= ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnDragDropHold; + bool hovered, held; + bool pressed = ButtonBehavior(bb, id, &hovered, &held, button_flags); + if (pressed && !is_tab_button) + tab_bar->NextSelectedTabId = id; + + // Allow the close button to overlap unless we are dragging (in which case we don't want any overlapping tabs to be hovered) + if (g.ActiveId != id) + SetItemAllowOverlap(); + + // Drag and drop: re-order tabs + if (held && !tab_appearing && IsMouseDragging(0)) + { + if (!g.DragDropActive && (tab_bar->Flags & ImGuiTabBarFlags_Reorderable)) + { + // While moving a tab it will jump on the other side of the mouse, so we also test for MouseDelta.x + if (g.IO.MouseDelta.x < 0.0f && g.IO.MousePos.x < bb.Min.x) + { + TabBarQueueReorderFromMousePos(tab_bar, tab, g.IO.MousePos); + } + else if (g.IO.MouseDelta.x > 0.0f && g.IO.MousePos.x > bb.Max.x) + { + TabBarQueueReorderFromMousePos(tab_bar, tab, g.IO.MousePos); + } + } + } + +#if 0 + if (hovered && g.HoveredIdNotActiveTimer > TOOLTIP_DELAY && bb.GetWidth() < tab->ContentWidth) + { + // Enlarge tab display when hovering + bb.Max.x = bb.Min.x + IM_FLOOR(ImLerp(bb.GetWidth(), tab->ContentWidth, ImSaturate((g.HoveredIdNotActiveTimer - 0.40f) * 6.0f))); + display_draw_list = GetForegroundDrawList(window); + TabItemBackground(display_draw_list, bb, flags, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_TitleBgActive)); + } +#endif + + // Render tab shape + ImDrawList* display_draw_list = window->DrawList; + const ImU32 tab_col = GetColorU32((held || hovered) ? ImGuiCol_TabHovered : tab_contents_visible ? (tab_bar_focused ? ImGuiCol_TabActive : ImGuiCol_TabUnfocusedActive) : (tab_bar_focused ? ImGuiCol_Tab : ImGuiCol_TabUnfocused)); + TabItemBackground(display_draw_list, bb, flags, tab_col); + RenderNavHighlight(bb, id); + + // Select with right mouse button. This is so the common idiom for context menu automatically highlight the current widget. + const bool hovered_unblocked = IsItemHovered(ImGuiHoveredFlags_AllowWhenBlockedByPopup); + if (hovered_unblocked && (IsMouseClicked(1) || IsMouseReleased(1))) + if (!is_tab_button) + tab_bar->NextSelectedTabId = id; + + if (tab_bar->Flags & ImGuiTabBarFlags_NoCloseWithMiddleMouseButton) + flags |= ImGuiTabItemFlags_NoCloseWithMiddleMouseButton; + + // Render tab label, process close button + const ImGuiID close_button_id = p_open ? GetIDWithSeed("#CLOSE", NULL, id) : 0; + bool just_closed; + bool text_clipped; + TabItemLabelAndCloseButton(display_draw_list, bb, flags, tab_bar->FramePadding, label, id, close_button_id, tab_contents_visible, &just_closed, &text_clipped); + if (just_closed && p_open != NULL) + { + *p_open = false; + TabBarCloseTab(tab_bar, tab); + } + + // Restore main window position so user can draw there + if (want_clip_rect) + PopClipRect(); + window->DC.CursorPos = backup_main_cursor_pos; + + // Tooltip + // (Won't work over the close button because ItemOverlap systems messes up with HoveredIdTimer-> seems ok) + // (We test IsItemHovered() to discard e.g. when another item is active or drag and drop over the tab bar, which g.HoveredId ignores) + // FIXME: This is a mess. + // FIXME: We may want disabled tab to still display the tooltip? + if (text_clipped && g.HoveredId == id && !held && g.HoveredIdNotActiveTimer > g.TooltipSlowDelay && IsItemHovered()) + if (!(tab_bar->Flags & ImGuiTabBarFlags_NoTooltip) && !(tab->Flags & ImGuiTabItemFlags_NoTooltip)) + SetTooltip("%.*s", (int)(FindRenderedTextEnd(label) - label), label); + + IM_ASSERT(!is_tab_button || !(tab_bar->SelectedTabId == tab->ID && is_tab_button)); // TabItemButton should not be selected + if (is_tab_button) + return pressed; + return tab_contents_visible; +} + +// [Public] This is call is 100% optional but it allows to remove some one-frame glitches when a tab has been unexpectedly removed. +// To use it to need to call the function SetTabItemClosed() between BeginTabBar() and EndTabBar(). +// Tabs closed by the close button will automatically be flagged to avoid this issue. +void ImGui::SetTabItemClosed(const char* label) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + bool is_within_manual_tab_bar = g.CurrentTabBar && !(g.CurrentTabBar->Flags & ImGuiTabBarFlags_DockNode); + if (is_within_manual_tab_bar) + { + ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar = g.CurrentTabBar; + ImGuiID tab_id = TabBarCalcTabID(tab_bar, label); + if (ImGuiTabItem* tab = TabBarFindTabByID(tab_bar, tab_id)) + tab->WantClose = true; // Will be processed by next call to TabBarLayout() + } +} + +ImVec2 ImGui::TabItemCalcSize(const char* label, bool has_close_button) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true); + ImVec2 size = ImVec2(label_size.x + g.Style.FramePadding.x, label_size.y + g.Style.FramePadding.y * 2.0f); + if (has_close_button) + size.x += g.Style.FramePadding.x + (g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x + g.FontSize); // We use Y intentionally to fit the close button circle. + else + size.x += g.Style.FramePadding.x + 1.0f; + return ImVec2(ImMin(size.x, TabBarCalcMaxTabWidth()), size.y); +} + +void ImGui::TabItemBackground(ImDrawList* draw_list, const ImRect& bb, ImGuiTabItemFlags flags, ImU32 col) +{ + // While rendering tabs, we trim 1 pixel off the top of our bounding box so they can fit within a regular frame height while looking "detached" from it. + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + const float width = bb.GetWidth(); + IM_UNUSED(flags); + IM_ASSERT(width > 0.0f); + const float rounding = ImMax(0.0f, ImMin((flags & ImGuiTabItemFlags_Button) ? g.Style.FrameRounding : g.Style.TabRounding, width * 0.5f - 1.0f)); + const float y1 = bb.Min.y + 1.0f; + const float y2 = bb.Max.y - 1.0f; + draw_list->PathLineTo(ImVec2(bb.Min.x, y2)); + draw_list->PathArcToFast(ImVec2(bb.Min.x + rounding, y1 + rounding), rounding, 6, 9); + draw_list->PathArcToFast(ImVec2(bb.Max.x - rounding, y1 + rounding), rounding, 9, 12); + draw_list->PathLineTo(ImVec2(bb.Max.x, y2)); + draw_list->PathFillConvex(col); + if (g.Style.TabBorderSize > 0.0f) + { + draw_list->PathLineTo(ImVec2(bb.Min.x + 0.5f, y2)); + draw_list->PathArcToFast(ImVec2(bb.Min.x + rounding + 0.5f, y1 + rounding + 0.5f), rounding, 6, 9); + draw_list->PathArcToFast(ImVec2(bb.Max.x - rounding - 0.5f, y1 + rounding + 0.5f), rounding, 9, 12); + draw_list->PathLineTo(ImVec2(bb.Max.x - 0.5f, y2)); + draw_list->PathStroke(GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Border), 0, g.Style.TabBorderSize); + } +} + +// Render text label (with custom clipping) + Unsaved Document marker + Close Button logic +// We tend to lock style.FramePadding for a given tab-bar, hence the 'frame_padding' parameter. +void ImGui::TabItemLabelAndCloseButton(ImDrawList* draw_list, const ImRect& bb, ImGuiTabItemFlags flags, ImVec2 frame_padding, const char* label, ImGuiID tab_id, ImGuiID close_button_id, bool is_contents_visible, bool* out_just_closed, bool* out_text_clipped) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true); + + if (out_just_closed) + *out_just_closed = false; + if (out_text_clipped) + *out_text_clipped = false; + + if (bb.GetWidth() <= 1.0f) + return; + + // In Style V2 we'll have full override of all colors per state (e.g. focused, selected) + // But right now if you want to alter text color of tabs this is what you need to do. +#if 0 + const float backup_alpha = g.Style.Alpha; + if (!is_contents_visible) + g.Style.Alpha *= 0.7f; +#endif + + // Render text label (with clipping + alpha gradient) + unsaved marker + ImRect text_pixel_clip_bb(bb.Min.x + frame_padding.x, bb.Min.y + frame_padding.y, bb.Max.x - frame_padding.x, bb.Max.y); + ImRect text_ellipsis_clip_bb = text_pixel_clip_bb; + + // Return clipped state ignoring the close button + if (out_text_clipped) + { + *out_text_clipped = (text_ellipsis_clip_bb.Min.x + label_size.x) > text_pixel_clip_bb.Max.x; + //draw_list->AddCircle(text_ellipsis_clip_bb.Min, 3.0f, *out_text_clipped ? IM_COL32(255, 0, 0, 255) : IM_COL32(0, 255, 0, 255)); + } + + const float button_sz = g.FontSize; + const ImVec2 button_pos(ImMax(bb.Min.x, bb.Max.x - frame_padding.x * 2.0f - button_sz), bb.Min.y); + + // Close Button & Unsaved Marker + // We are relying on a subtle and confusing distinction between 'hovered' and 'g.HoveredId' which happens because we are using ImGuiButtonFlags_AllowOverlapMode + SetItemAllowOverlap() + // 'hovered' will be true when hovering the Tab but NOT when hovering the close button + // 'g.HoveredId==id' will be true when hovering the Tab including when hovering the close button + // 'g.ActiveId==close_button_id' will be true when we are holding on the close button, in which case both hovered booleans are false + bool close_button_pressed = false; + bool close_button_visible = false; + if (close_button_id != 0) + if (is_contents_visible || bb.GetWidth() >= ImMax(button_sz, g.Style.TabMinWidthForCloseButton)) + if (g.HoveredId == tab_id || g.HoveredId == close_button_id || g.ActiveId == tab_id || g.ActiveId == close_button_id) + close_button_visible = true; + bool unsaved_marker_visible = (flags & ImGuiTabItemFlags_UnsavedDocument) != 0 && (button_pos.x + button_sz <= bb.Max.x); + + if (close_button_visible) + { + ImGuiLastItemData last_item_backup = g.LastItemData; + PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_FramePadding, frame_padding); + if (CloseButton(close_button_id, button_pos)) + close_button_pressed = true; + PopStyleVar(); + g.LastItemData = last_item_backup; + + // Close with middle mouse button + if (!(flags & ImGuiTabItemFlags_NoCloseWithMiddleMouseButton) && IsMouseClicked(2)) + close_button_pressed = true; + } + else if (unsaved_marker_visible) + { + const ImRect bullet_bb(button_pos, button_pos + ImVec2(button_sz, button_sz) + g.Style.FramePadding * 2.0f); + RenderBullet(draw_list, bullet_bb.GetCenter(), GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text)); + } + + // This is all rather complicated + // (the main idea is that because the close button only appears on hover, we don't want it to alter the ellipsis position) + // FIXME: if FramePadding is noticeably large, ellipsis_max_x will be wrong here (e.g. #3497), maybe for consistency that parameter of RenderTextEllipsis() shouldn't exist.. + float ellipsis_max_x = close_button_visible ? text_pixel_clip_bb.Max.x : bb.Max.x - 1.0f; + if (close_button_visible || unsaved_marker_visible) + { + text_pixel_clip_bb.Max.x -= close_button_visible ? (button_sz) : (button_sz * 0.80f); + text_ellipsis_clip_bb.Max.x -= unsaved_marker_visible ? (button_sz * 0.80f) : 0.0f; + ellipsis_max_x = text_pixel_clip_bb.Max.x; + } + RenderTextEllipsis(draw_list, text_ellipsis_clip_bb.Min, text_ellipsis_clip_bb.Max, text_pixel_clip_bb.Max.x, ellipsis_max_x, label, NULL, &label_size); + +#if 0 + if (!is_contents_visible) + g.Style.Alpha = backup_alpha; +#endif + + if (out_just_closed) + *out_just_closed = close_button_pressed; +} + + +#endif // #ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE diff --git a/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/imgui-1.84.2/imstb_rectpack.h b/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/imgui-1.84.2/imstb_rectpack.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000..3958952 --- /dev/null +++ b/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/imgui-1.84.2/imstb_rectpack.h @@ -0,0 +1,639 @@ +// [DEAR IMGUI] +// This is a slightly modified version of stb_rect_pack.h 1.00. +// Those changes would need to be pushed into nothings/stb: +// - Added STBRP__CDECL +// Grep for [DEAR IMGUI] to find the changes. + +// stb_rect_pack.h - v1.00 - public domain - rectangle packing +// Sean Barrett 2014 +// +// Useful for e.g. packing rectangular textures into an atlas. +// Does not do rotation. +// +// Not necessarily the awesomest packing method, but better than +// the totally naive one in stb_truetype (which is primarily what +// this is meant to replace). +// +// Has only had a few tests run, may have issues. +// +// More docs to come. +// +// No memory allocations; uses qsort() and assert() from stdlib. +// Can override those by defining STBRP_SORT and STBRP_ASSERT. +// +// This library currently uses the Skyline Bottom-Left algorithm. +// +// Please note: better rectangle packers are welcome! Please +// implement them to the same API, but with a different init +// function. +// +// Credits +// +// Library +// Sean Barrett +// Minor features +// Martins Mozeiko +// github:IntellectualKitty +// +// Bugfixes / warning fixes +// Jeremy Jaussaud +// Fabian Giesen +// +// Version history: +// +// 1.00 (2019-02-25) avoid small space waste; gracefully fail too-wide rectangles +// 0.99 (2019-02-07) warning fixes +// 0.11 (2017-03-03) return packing success/fail result +// 0.10 (2016-10-25) remove cast-away-const to avoid warnings +// 0.09 (2016-08-27) fix compiler warnings +// 0.08 (2015-09-13) really fix bug with empty rects (w=0 or h=0) +// 0.07 (2015-09-13) fix bug with empty rects (w=0 or h=0) +// 0.06 (2015-04-15) added STBRP_SORT to allow replacing qsort +// 0.05: added STBRP_ASSERT to allow replacing assert +// 0.04: fixed minor bug in STBRP_LARGE_RECTS support +// 0.01: initial release +// +// LICENSE +// +// See end of file for license information. + +////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +// +// INCLUDE SECTION +// + +#ifndef STB_INCLUDE_STB_RECT_PACK_H +#define STB_INCLUDE_STB_RECT_PACK_H + +#define STB_RECT_PACK_VERSION 1 + +#ifdef STBRP_STATIC +#define STBRP_DEF static +#else +#define STBRP_DEF extern +#endif + +#ifdef __cplusplus +extern "C" { +#endif + +typedef struct stbrp_context stbrp_context; +typedef struct stbrp_node stbrp_node; +typedef struct stbrp_rect stbrp_rect; + +#ifdef STBRP_LARGE_RECTS +typedef int stbrp_coord; +#else +typedef unsigned short stbrp_coord; +#endif + +STBRP_DEF int stbrp_pack_rects (stbrp_context *context, stbrp_rect *rects, int num_rects); +// Assign packed locations to rectangles. The rectangles are of type +// 'stbrp_rect' defined below, stored in the array 'rects', and there +// are 'num_rects' many of them. +// +// Rectangles which are successfully packed have the 'was_packed' flag +// set to a non-zero value and 'x' and 'y' store the minimum location +// on each axis (i.e. bottom-left in cartesian coordinates, top-left +// if you imagine y increasing downwards). Rectangles which do not fit +// have the 'was_packed' flag set to 0. +// +// You should not try to access the 'rects' array from another thread +// while this function is running, as the function temporarily reorders +// the array while it executes. +// +// To pack into another rectangle, you need to call stbrp_init_target +// again. To continue packing into the same rectangle, you can call +// this function again. Calling this multiple times with multiple rect +// arrays will probably produce worse packing results than calling it +// a single time with the full rectangle array, but the option is +// available. +// +// The function returns 1 if all of the rectangles were successfully +// packed and 0 otherwise. + +struct stbrp_rect +{ + // reserved for your use: + int id; + + // input: + stbrp_coord w, h; + + // output: + stbrp_coord x, y; + int was_packed; // non-zero if valid packing + +}; // 16 bytes, nominally + + +STBRP_DEF void stbrp_init_target (stbrp_context *context, int width, int height, stbrp_node *nodes, int num_nodes); +// Initialize a rectangle packer to: +// pack a rectangle that is 'width' by 'height' in dimensions +// using temporary storage provided by the array 'nodes', which is 'num_nodes' long +// +// You must call this function every time you start packing into a new target. +// +// There is no "shutdown" function. The 'nodes' memory must stay valid for +// the following stbrp_pack_rects() call (or calls), but can be freed after +// the call (or calls) finish. +// +// Note: to guarantee best results, either: +// 1. make sure 'num_nodes' >= 'width' +// or 2. call stbrp_allow_out_of_mem() defined below with 'allow_out_of_mem = 1' +// +// If you don't do either of the above things, widths will be quantized to multiples +// of small integers to guarantee the algorithm doesn't run out of temporary storage. +// +// If you do #2, then the non-quantized algorithm will be used, but the algorithm +// may run out of temporary storage and be unable to pack some rectangles. + +STBRP_DEF void stbrp_setup_allow_out_of_mem (stbrp_context *context, int allow_out_of_mem); +// Optionally call this function after init but before doing any packing to +// change the handling of the out-of-temp-memory scenario, described above. +// If you call init again, this will be reset to the default (false). + + +STBRP_DEF void stbrp_setup_heuristic (stbrp_context *context, int heuristic); +// Optionally select which packing heuristic the library should use. Different +// heuristics will produce better/worse results for different data sets. +// If you call init again, this will be reset to the default. + +enum +{ + STBRP_HEURISTIC_Skyline_default=0, + STBRP_HEURISTIC_Skyline_BL_sortHeight = STBRP_HEURISTIC_Skyline_default, + STBRP_HEURISTIC_Skyline_BF_sortHeight +}; + + +////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +// +// the details of the following structures don't matter to you, but they must +// be visible so you can handle the memory allocations for them + +struct stbrp_node +{ + stbrp_coord x,y; + stbrp_node *next; +}; + +struct stbrp_context +{ + int width; + int height; + int align; + int init_mode; + int heuristic; + int num_nodes; + stbrp_node *active_head; + stbrp_node *free_head; + stbrp_node extra[2]; // we allocate two extra nodes so optimal user-node-count is 'width' not 'width+2' +}; + +#ifdef __cplusplus +} +#endif + +#endif + +////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +// +// IMPLEMENTATION SECTION +// + +#ifdef STB_RECT_PACK_IMPLEMENTATION +#ifndef STBRP_SORT +#include +#define STBRP_SORT qsort +#endif + +#ifndef STBRP_ASSERT +#include +#define STBRP_ASSERT assert +#endif + +// [DEAR IMGUI] Added STBRP__CDECL +#ifdef _MSC_VER +#define STBRP__NOTUSED(v) (void)(v) +#define STBRP__CDECL __cdecl +#else +#define STBRP__NOTUSED(v) (void)sizeof(v) +#define STBRP__CDECL +#endif + +enum +{ + STBRP__INIT_skyline = 1 +}; + +STBRP_DEF void stbrp_setup_heuristic(stbrp_context *context, int heuristic) +{ + switch (context->init_mode) { + case STBRP__INIT_skyline: + STBRP_ASSERT(heuristic == STBRP_HEURISTIC_Skyline_BL_sortHeight || heuristic == STBRP_HEURISTIC_Skyline_BF_sortHeight); + context->heuristic = heuristic; + break; + default: + STBRP_ASSERT(0); + } +} + +STBRP_DEF void stbrp_setup_allow_out_of_mem(stbrp_context *context, int allow_out_of_mem) +{ + if (allow_out_of_mem) + // if it's ok to run out of memory, then don't bother aligning them; + // this gives better packing, but may fail due to OOM (even though + // the rectangles easily fit). @TODO a smarter approach would be to only + // quantize once we've hit OOM, then we could get rid of this parameter. + context->align = 1; + else { + // if it's not ok to run out of memory, then quantize the widths + // so that num_nodes is always enough nodes. + // + // I.e. num_nodes * align >= width + // align >= width / num_nodes + // align = ceil(width/num_nodes) + + context->align = (context->width + context->num_nodes-1) / context->num_nodes; + } +} + +STBRP_DEF void stbrp_init_target(stbrp_context *context, int width, int height, stbrp_node *nodes, int num_nodes) +{ + int i; +#ifndef STBRP_LARGE_RECTS + STBRP_ASSERT(width <= 0xffff && height <= 0xffff); +#endif + + for (i=0; i < num_nodes-1; ++i) + nodes[i].next = &nodes[i+1]; + nodes[i].next = NULL; + context->init_mode = STBRP__INIT_skyline; + context->heuristic = STBRP_HEURISTIC_Skyline_default; + context->free_head = &nodes[0]; + context->active_head = &context->extra[0]; + context->width = width; + context->height = height; + context->num_nodes = num_nodes; + stbrp_setup_allow_out_of_mem(context, 0); + + // node 0 is the full width, node 1 is the sentinel (lets us not store width explicitly) + context->extra[0].x = 0; + context->extra[0].y = 0; + context->extra[0].next = &context->extra[1]; + context->extra[1].x = (stbrp_coord) width; +#ifdef STBRP_LARGE_RECTS + context->extra[1].y = (1<<30); +#else + context->extra[1].y = 65535; +#endif + context->extra[1].next = NULL; +} + +// find minimum y position if it starts at x1 +static int stbrp__skyline_find_min_y(stbrp_context *c, stbrp_node *first, int x0, int width, int *pwaste) +{ + stbrp_node *node = first; + int x1 = x0 + width; + int min_y, visited_width, waste_area; + + STBRP__NOTUSED(c); + + STBRP_ASSERT(first->x <= x0); + + #if 0 + // skip in case we're past the node + while (node->next->x <= x0) + ++node; + #else + STBRP_ASSERT(node->next->x > x0); // we ended up handling this in the caller for efficiency + #endif + + STBRP_ASSERT(node->x <= x0); + + min_y = 0; + waste_area = 0; + visited_width = 0; + while (node->x < x1) { + if (node->y > min_y) { + // raise min_y higher. + // we've accounted for all waste up to min_y, + // but we'll now add more waste for everything we've visted + waste_area += visited_width * (node->y - min_y); + min_y = node->y; + // the first time through, visited_width might be reduced + if (node->x < x0) + visited_width += node->next->x - x0; + else + visited_width += node->next->x - node->x; + } else { + // add waste area + int under_width = node->next->x - node->x; + if (under_width + visited_width > width) + under_width = width - visited_width; + waste_area += under_width * (min_y - node->y); + visited_width += under_width; + } + node = node->next; + } + + *pwaste = waste_area; + return min_y; +} + +typedef struct +{ + int x,y; + stbrp_node **prev_link; +} stbrp__findresult; + +static stbrp__findresult stbrp__skyline_find_best_pos(stbrp_context *c, int width, int height) +{ + int best_waste = (1<<30), best_x, best_y = (1 << 30); + stbrp__findresult fr; + stbrp_node **prev, *node, *tail, **best = NULL; + + // align to multiple of c->align + width = (width + c->align - 1); + width -= width % c->align; + STBRP_ASSERT(width % c->align == 0); + + // if it can't possibly fit, bail immediately + if (width > c->width || height > c->height) { + fr.prev_link = NULL; + fr.x = fr.y = 0; + return fr; + } + + node = c->active_head; + prev = &c->active_head; + while (node->x + width <= c->width) { + int y,waste; + y = stbrp__skyline_find_min_y(c, node, node->x, width, &waste); + if (c->heuristic == STBRP_HEURISTIC_Skyline_BL_sortHeight) { // actually just want to test BL + // bottom left + if (y < best_y) { + best_y = y; + best = prev; + } + } else { + // best-fit + if (y + height <= c->height) { + // can only use it if it first vertically + if (y < best_y || (y == best_y && waste < best_waste)) { + best_y = y; + best_waste = waste; + best = prev; + } + } + } + prev = &node->next; + node = node->next; + } + + best_x = (best == NULL) ? 0 : (*best)->x; + + // if doing best-fit (BF), we also have to try aligning right edge to each node position + // + // e.g, if fitting + // + // ____________________ + // |____________________| + // + // into + // + // | | + // | ____________| + // |____________| + // + // then right-aligned reduces waste, but bottom-left BL is always chooses left-aligned + // + // This makes BF take about 2x the time + + if (c->heuristic == STBRP_HEURISTIC_Skyline_BF_sortHeight) { + tail = c->active_head; + node = c->active_head; + prev = &c->active_head; + // find first node that's admissible + while (tail->x < width) + tail = tail->next; + while (tail) { + int xpos = tail->x - width; + int y,waste; + STBRP_ASSERT(xpos >= 0); + // find the left position that matches this + while (node->next->x <= xpos) { + prev = &node->next; + node = node->next; + } + STBRP_ASSERT(node->next->x > xpos && node->x <= xpos); + y = stbrp__skyline_find_min_y(c, node, xpos, width, &waste); + if (y + height <= c->height) { + if (y <= best_y) { + if (y < best_y || waste < best_waste || (waste==best_waste && xpos < best_x)) { + best_x = xpos; + STBRP_ASSERT(y <= best_y); + best_y = y; + best_waste = waste; + best = prev; + } + } + } + tail = tail->next; + } + } + + fr.prev_link = best; + fr.x = best_x; + fr.y = best_y; + return fr; +} + +static stbrp__findresult stbrp__skyline_pack_rectangle(stbrp_context *context, int width, int height) +{ + // find best position according to heuristic + stbrp__findresult res = stbrp__skyline_find_best_pos(context, width, height); + stbrp_node *node, *cur; + + // bail if: + // 1. it failed + // 2. the best node doesn't fit (we don't always check this) + // 3. we're out of memory + if (res.prev_link == NULL || res.y + height > context->height || context->free_head == NULL) { + res.prev_link = NULL; + return res; + } + + // on success, create new node + node = context->free_head; + node->x = (stbrp_coord) res.x; + node->y = (stbrp_coord) (res.y + height); + + context->free_head = node->next; + + // insert the new node into the right starting point, and + // let 'cur' point to the remaining nodes needing to be + // stiched back in + + cur = *res.prev_link; + if (cur->x < res.x) { + // preserve the existing one, so start testing with the next one + stbrp_node *next = cur->next; + cur->next = node; + cur = next; + } else { + *res.prev_link = node; + } + + // from here, traverse cur and free the nodes, until we get to one + // that shouldn't be freed + while (cur->next && cur->next->x <= res.x + width) { + stbrp_node *next = cur->next; + // move the current node to the free list + cur->next = context->free_head; + context->free_head = cur; + cur = next; + } + + // stitch the list back in + node->next = cur; + + if (cur->x < res.x + width) + cur->x = (stbrp_coord) (res.x + width); + +#ifdef _DEBUG + cur = context->active_head; + while (cur->x < context->width) { + STBRP_ASSERT(cur->x < cur->next->x); + cur = cur->next; + } + STBRP_ASSERT(cur->next == NULL); + + { + int count=0; + cur = context->active_head; + while (cur) { + cur = cur->next; + ++count; + } + cur = context->free_head; + while (cur) { + cur = cur->next; + ++count; + } + STBRP_ASSERT(count == context->num_nodes+2); + } +#endif + + return res; +} + +// [DEAR IMGUI] Added STBRP__CDECL +static int STBRP__CDECL rect_height_compare(const void *a, const void *b) +{ + const stbrp_rect *p = (const stbrp_rect *) a; + const stbrp_rect *q = (const stbrp_rect *) b; + if (p->h > q->h) + return -1; + if (p->h < q->h) + return 1; + return (p->w > q->w) ? -1 : (p->w < q->w); +} + +// [DEAR IMGUI] Added STBRP__CDECL +static int STBRP__CDECL rect_original_order(const void *a, const void *b) +{ + const stbrp_rect *p = (const stbrp_rect *) a; + const stbrp_rect *q = (const stbrp_rect *) b; + return (p->was_packed < q->was_packed) ? -1 : (p->was_packed > q->was_packed); +} + +#ifdef STBRP_LARGE_RECTS +#define STBRP__MAXVAL 0xffffffff +#else +#define STBRP__MAXVAL 0xffff +#endif + +STBRP_DEF int stbrp_pack_rects(stbrp_context *context, stbrp_rect *rects, int num_rects) +{ + int i, all_rects_packed = 1; + + // we use the 'was_packed' field internally to allow sorting/unsorting + for (i=0; i < num_rects; ++i) { + rects[i].was_packed = i; + } + + // sort according to heuristic + STBRP_SORT(rects, num_rects, sizeof(rects[0]), rect_height_compare); + + for (i=0; i < num_rects; ++i) { + if (rects[i].w == 0 || rects[i].h == 0) { + rects[i].x = rects[i].y = 0; // empty rect needs no space + } else { + stbrp__findresult fr = stbrp__skyline_pack_rectangle(context, rects[i].w, rects[i].h); + if (fr.prev_link) { + rects[i].x = (stbrp_coord) fr.x; + rects[i].y = (stbrp_coord) fr.y; + } else { + rects[i].x = rects[i].y = STBRP__MAXVAL; + } + } + } + + // unsort + STBRP_SORT(rects, num_rects, sizeof(rects[0]), rect_original_order); + + // set was_packed flags and all_rects_packed status + for (i=0; i < num_rects; ++i) { + rects[i].was_packed = !(rects[i].x == STBRP__MAXVAL && rects[i].y == STBRP__MAXVAL); + if (!rects[i].was_packed) + all_rects_packed = 0; + } + + // return the all_rects_packed status + return all_rects_packed; +} +#endif + +/* +------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +This software is available under 2 licenses -- choose whichever you prefer. +------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +ALTERNATIVE A - MIT License +Copyright (c) 2017 Sean Barrett +Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy of +this software and associated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal in +the Software without restriction, including without limitation the rights to +use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies +of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do +so, subject to the following conditions: +The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in all +copies or substantial portions of the Software. +THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR +IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, +FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE +AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER +LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, +OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE +SOFTWARE. +------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +ALTERNATIVE B - Public Domain (www.unlicense.org) +This is free and unencumbered software released into the public domain. +Anyone is free to copy, modify, publish, use, compile, sell, or distribute this +software, either in source code form or as a compiled binary, for any purpose, +commercial or non-commercial, and by any means. +In jurisdictions that recognize copyright laws, the author or authors of this +software dedicate any and all copyright interest in the software to the public +domain. We make this dedication for the benefit of the public at large and to +the detriment of our heirs and successors. We intend this dedication to be an +overt act of relinquishment in perpetuity of all present and future rights to +this software under copyright law. +THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR +IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, +FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE +AUTHORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN +ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION +WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. +------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +*/ diff --git a/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/imgui-1.84.2/imstb_textedit.h b/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/imgui-1.84.2/imstb_textedit.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000..2c635b2 --- /dev/null +++ b/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/imgui-1.84.2/imstb_textedit.h @@ -0,0 +1,1449 @@ +// [DEAR IMGUI] +// This is a slightly modified version of stb_textedit.h 1.13. +// Those changes would need to be pushed into nothings/stb: +// - Fix in stb_textedit_discard_redo (see https://github.com/nothings/stb/issues/321) +// Grep for [DEAR IMGUI] to find the changes. + +// stb_textedit.h - v1.13 - public domain - Sean Barrett +// Development of this library was sponsored by RAD Game Tools +// +// This C header file implements the guts of a multi-line text-editing +// widget; you implement display, word-wrapping, and low-level string +// insertion/deletion, and stb_textedit will map user inputs into +// insertions & deletions, plus updates to the cursor position, +// selection state, and undo state. +// +// It is intended for use in games and other systems that need to build +// their own custom widgets and which do not have heavy text-editing +// requirements (this library is not recommended for use for editing large +// texts, as its performance does not scale and it has limited undo). +// +// Non-trivial behaviors are modelled after Windows text controls. +// +// +// LICENSE +// +// See end of file for license information. +// +// +// DEPENDENCIES +// +// Uses the C runtime function 'memmove', which you can override +// by defining STB_TEXTEDIT_memmove before the implementation. +// Uses no other functions. Performs no runtime allocations. +// +// +// VERSION HISTORY +// +// 1.13 (2019-02-07) fix bug in undo size management +// 1.12 (2018-01-29) user can change STB_TEXTEDIT_KEYTYPE, fix redo to avoid crash +// 1.11 (2017-03-03) fix HOME on last line, dragging off single-line textfield +// 1.10 (2016-10-25) supress warnings about casting away const with -Wcast-qual +// 1.9 (2016-08-27) customizable move-by-word +// 1.8 (2016-04-02) better keyboard handling when mouse button is down +// 1.7 (2015-09-13) change y range handling in case baseline is non-0 +// 1.6 (2015-04-15) allow STB_TEXTEDIT_memmove +// 1.5 (2014-09-10) add support for secondary keys for OS X +// 1.4 (2014-08-17) fix signed/unsigned warnings +// 1.3 (2014-06-19) fix mouse clicking to round to nearest char boundary +// 1.2 (2014-05-27) fix some RAD types that had crept into the new code +// 1.1 (2013-12-15) move-by-word (requires STB_TEXTEDIT_IS_SPACE ) +// 1.0 (2012-07-26) improve documentation, initial public release +// 0.3 (2012-02-24) bugfixes, single-line mode; insert mode +// 0.2 (2011-11-28) fixes to undo/redo +// 0.1 (2010-07-08) initial version +// +// ADDITIONAL CONTRIBUTORS +// +// Ulf Winklemann: move-by-word in 1.1 +// Fabian Giesen: secondary key inputs in 1.5 +// Martins Mozeiko: STB_TEXTEDIT_memmove in 1.6 +// +// Bugfixes: +// Scott Graham +// Daniel Keller +// Omar Cornut +// Dan Thompson +// +// USAGE +// +// This file behaves differently depending on what symbols you define +// before including it. +// +// +// Header-file mode: +// +// If you do not define STB_TEXTEDIT_IMPLEMENTATION before including this, +// it will operate in "header file" mode. In this mode, it declares a +// single public symbol, STB_TexteditState, which encapsulates the current +// state of a text widget (except for the string, which you will store +// separately). +// +// To compile in this mode, you must define STB_TEXTEDIT_CHARTYPE to a +// primitive type that defines a single character (e.g. char, wchar_t, etc). +// +// To save space or increase undo-ability, you can optionally define the +// following things that are used by the undo system: +// +// STB_TEXTEDIT_POSITIONTYPE small int type encoding a valid cursor position +// STB_TEXTEDIT_UNDOSTATECOUNT the number of undo states to allow +// STB_TEXTEDIT_UNDOCHARCOUNT the number of characters to store in the undo buffer +// +// If you don't define these, they are set to permissive types and +// moderate sizes. The undo system does no memory allocations, so +// it grows STB_TexteditState by the worst-case storage which is (in bytes): +// +// [4 + 3 * sizeof(STB_TEXTEDIT_POSITIONTYPE)] * STB_TEXTEDIT_UNDOSTATE_COUNT +// + sizeof(STB_TEXTEDIT_CHARTYPE) * STB_TEXTEDIT_UNDOCHAR_COUNT +// +// +// Implementation mode: +// +// If you define STB_TEXTEDIT_IMPLEMENTATION before including this, it +// will compile the implementation of the text edit widget, depending +// on a large number of symbols which must be defined before the include. +// +// The implementation is defined only as static functions. You will then +// need to provide your own APIs in the same file which will access the +// static functions. +// +// The basic concept is that you provide a "string" object which +// behaves like an array of characters. stb_textedit uses indices to +// refer to positions in the string, implicitly representing positions +// in the displayed textedit. This is true for both plain text and +// rich text; even with rich text stb_truetype interacts with your +// code as if there was an array of all the displayed characters. +// +// Symbols that must be the same in header-file and implementation mode: +// +// STB_TEXTEDIT_CHARTYPE the character type +// STB_TEXTEDIT_POSITIONTYPE small type that is a valid cursor position +// STB_TEXTEDIT_UNDOSTATECOUNT the number of undo states to allow +// STB_TEXTEDIT_UNDOCHARCOUNT the number of characters to store in the undo buffer +// +// Symbols you must define for implementation mode: +// +// STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING the type of object representing a string being edited, +// typically this is a wrapper object with other data you need +// +// STB_TEXTEDIT_STRINGLEN(obj) the length of the string (ideally O(1)) +// STB_TEXTEDIT_LAYOUTROW(&r,obj,n) returns the results of laying out a line of characters +// starting from character #n (see discussion below) +// STB_TEXTEDIT_GETWIDTH(obj,n,i) returns the pixel delta from the xpos of the i'th character +// to the xpos of the i+1'th char for a line of characters +// starting at character #n (i.e. accounts for kerning +// with previous char) +// STB_TEXTEDIT_KEYTOTEXT(k) maps a keyboard input to an insertable character +// (return type is int, -1 means not valid to insert) +// STB_TEXTEDIT_GETCHAR(obj,i) returns the i'th character of obj, 0-based +// STB_TEXTEDIT_NEWLINE the character returned by _GETCHAR() we recognize +// as manually wordwrapping for end-of-line positioning +// +// STB_TEXTEDIT_DELETECHARS(obj,i,n) delete n characters starting at i +// STB_TEXTEDIT_INSERTCHARS(obj,i,c*,n) insert n characters at i (pointed to by STB_TEXTEDIT_CHARTYPE*) +// +// STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT a power of two that is or'd in to a keyboard input to represent the shift key +// +// STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LEFT keyboard input to move cursor left +// STB_TEXTEDIT_K_RIGHT keyboard input to move cursor right +// STB_TEXTEDIT_K_UP keyboard input to move cursor up +// STB_TEXTEDIT_K_DOWN keyboard input to move cursor down +// STB_TEXTEDIT_K_PGUP keyboard input to move cursor up a page +// STB_TEXTEDIT_K_PGDOWN keyboard input to move cursor down a page +// STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINESTART keyboard input to move cursor to start of line // e.g. HOME +// STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINEEND keyboard input to move cursor to end of line // e.g. END +// STB_TEXTEDIT_K_TEXTSTART keyboard input to move cursor to start of text // e.g. ctrl-HOME +// STB_TEXTEDIT_K_TEXTEND keyboard input to move cursor to end of text // e.g. ctrl-END +// STB_TEXTEDIT_K_DELETE keyboard input to delete selection or character under cursor +// STB_TEXTEDIT_K_BACKSPACE keyboard input to delete selection or character left of cursor +// STB_TEXTEDIT_K_UNDO keyboard input to perform undo +// STB_TEXTEDIT_K_REDO keyboard input to perform redo +// +// Optional: +// STB_TEXTEDIT_K_INSERT keyboard input to toggle insert mode +// STB_TEXTEDIT_IS_SPACE(ch) true if character is whitespace (e.g. 'isspace'), +// required for default WORDLEFT/WORDRIGHT handlers +// STB_TEXTEDIT_MOVEWORDLEFT(obj,i) custom handler for WORDLEFT, returns index to move cursor to +// STB_TEXTEDIT_MOVEWORDRIGHT(obj,i) custom handler for WORDRIGHT, returns index to move cursor to +// STB_TEXTEDIT_K_WORDLEFT keyboard input to move cursor left one word // e.g. ctrl-LEFT +// STB_TEXTEDIT_K_WORDRIGHT keyboard input to move cursor right one word // e.g. ctrl-RIGHT +// STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINESTART2 secondary keyboard input to move cursor to start of line +// STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINEEND2 secondary keyboard input to move cursor to end of line +// STB_TEXTEDIT_K_TEXTSTART2 secondary keyboard input to move cursor to start of text +// STB_TEXTEDIT_K_TEXTEND2 secondary keyboard input to move cursor to end of text +// +// Keyboard input must be encoded as a single integer value; e.g. a character code +// and some bitflags that represent shift states. to simplify the interface, SHIFT must +// be a bitflag, so we can test the shifted state of cursor movements to allow selection, +// i.e. (STB_TEXTEDIT_K_RIGHT|STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT) should be shifted right-arrow. +// +// You can encode other things, such as CONTROL or ALT, in additional bits, and +// then test for their presence in e.g. STB_TEXTEDIT_K_WORDLEFT. For example, +// my Windows implementations add an additional CONTROL bit, and an additional KEYDOWN +// bit. Then all of the STB_TEXTEDIT_K_ values bitwise-or in the KEYDOWN bit, +// and I pass both WM_KEYDOWN and WM_CHAR events to the "key" function in the +// API below. The control keys will only match WM_KEYDOWN events because of the +// keydown bit I add, and STB_TEXTEDIT_KEYTOTEXT only tests for the KEYDOWN +// bit so it only decodes WM_CHAR events. +// +// STB_TEXTEDIT_LAYOUTROW returns information about the shape of one displayed +// row of characters assuming they start on the i'th character--the width and +// the height and the number of characters consumed. This allows this library +// to traverse the entire layout incrementally. You need to compute word-wrapping +// here. +// +// Each textfield keeps its own insert mode state, which is not how normal +// applications work. To keep an app-wide insert mode, update/copy the +// "insert_mode" field of STB_TexteditState before/after calling API functions. +// +// API +// +// void stb_textedit_initialize_state(STB_TexteditState *state, int is_single_line) +// +// void stb_textedit_click(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING *str, STB_TexteditState *state, float x, float y) +// void stb_textedit_drag(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING *str, STB_TexteditState *state, float x, float y) +// int stb_textedit_cut(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING *str, STB_TexteditState *state) +// int stb_textedit_paste(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING *str, STB_TexteditState *state, STB_TEXTEDIT_CHARTYPE *text, int len) +// void stb_textedit_key(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING *str, STB_TexteditState *state, STB_TEXEDIT_KEYTYPE key) +// +// Each of these functions potentially updates the string and updates the +// state. +// +// initialize_state: +// set the textedit state to a known good default state when initially +// constructing the textedit. +// +// click: +// call this with the mouse x,y on a mouse down; it will update the cursor +// and reset the selection start/end to the cursor point. the x,y must +// be relative to the text widget, with (0,0) being the top left. +// +// drag: +// call this with the mouse x,y on a mouse drag/up; it will update the +// cursor and the selection end point +// +// cut: +// call this to delete the current selection; returns true if there was +// one. you should FIRST copy the current selection to the system paste buffer. +// (To copy, just copy the current selection out of the string yourself.) +// +// paste: +// call this to paste text at the current cursor point or over the current +// selection if there is one. +// +// key: +// call this for keyboard inputs sent to the textfield. you can use it +// for "key down" events or for "translated" key events. if you need to +// do both (as in Win32), or distinguish Unicode characters from control +// inputs, set a high bit to distinguish the two; then you can define the +// various definitions like STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LEFT have the is-key-event bit +// set, and make STB_TEXTEDIT_KEYTOCHAR check that the is-key-event bit is +// clear. STB_TEXTEDIT_KEYTYPE defaults to int, but you can #define it to +// anything other type you wante before including. +// +// +// When rendering, you can read the cursor position and selection state from +// the STB_TexteditState. +// +// +// Notes: +// +// This is designed to be usable in IMGUI, so it allows for the possibility of +// running in an IMGUI that has NOT cached the multi-line layout. For this +// reason, it provides an interface that is compatible with computing the +// layout incrementally--we try to make sure we make as few passes through +// as possible. (For example, to locate the mouse pointer in the text, we +// could define functions that return the X and Y positions of characters +// and binary search Y and then X, but if we're doing dynamic layout this +// will run the layout algorithm many times, so instead we manually search +// forward in one pass. Similar logic applies to e.g. up-arrow and +// down-arrow movement.) +// +// If it's run in a widget that *has* cached the layout, then this is less +// efficient, but it's not horrible on modern computers. But you wouldn't +// want to edit million-line files with it. + + +//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +//// +//// Header-file mode +//// +//// + +#ifndef INCLUDE_STB_TEXTEDIT_H +#define INCLUDE_STB_TEXTEDIT_H + +//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +// +// STB_TexteditState +// +// Definition of STB_TexteditState which you should store +// per-textfield; it includes cursor position, selection state, +// and undo state. +// + +#ifndef STB_TEXTEDIT_UNDOSTATECOUNT +#define STB_TEXTEDIT_UNDOSTATECOUNT 99 +#endif +#ifndef STB_TEXTEDIT_UNDOCHARCOUNT +#define STB_TEXTEDIT_UNDOCHARCOUNT 999 +#endif +#ifndef STB_TEXTEDIT_CHARTYPE +#define STB_TEXTEDIT_CHARTYPE int +#endif +#ifndef STB_TEXTEDIT_POSITIONTYPE +#define STB_TEXTEDIT_POSITIONTYPE int +#endif + +typedef struct +{ + // private data + STB_TEXTEDIT_POSITIONTYPE where; + STB_TEXTEDIT_POSITIONTYPE insert_length; + STB_TEXTEDIT_POSITIONTYPE delete_length; + int char_storage; +} StbUndoRecord; + +typedef struct +{ + // private data + StbUndoRecord undo_rec [STB_TEXTEDIT_UNDOSTATECOUNT]; + STB_TEXTEDIT_CHARTYPE undo_char[STB_TEXTEDIT_UNDOCHARCOUNT]; + short undo_point, redo_point; + int undo_char_point, redo_char_point; +} StbUndoState; + +typedef struct +{ + ///////////////////// + // + // public data + // + + int cursor; + // position of the text cursor within the string + + int select_start; // selection start point + int select_end; + // selection start and end point in characters; if equal, no selection. + // note that start may be less than or greater than end (e.g. when + // dragging the mouse, start is where the initial click was, and you + // can drag in either direction) + + unsigned char insert_mode; + // each textfield keeps its own insert mode state. to keep an app-wide + // insert mode, copy this value in/out of the app state + + int row_count_per_page; + // page size in number of row. + // this value MUST be set to >0 for pageup or pagedown in multilines documents. + + ///////////////////// + // + // private data + // + unsigned char cursor_at_end_of_line; // not implemented yet + unsigned char initialized; + unsigned char has_preferred_x; + unsigned char single_line; + unsigned char padding1, padding2, padding3; + float preferred_x; // this determines where the cursor up/down tries to seek to along x + StbUndoState undostate; +} STB_TexteditState; + + +//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +// +// StbTexteditRow +// +// Result of layout query, used by stb_textedit to determine where +// the text in each row is. + +// result of layout query +typedef struct +{ + float x0,x1; // starting x location, end x location (allows for align=right, etc) + float baseline_y_delta; // position of baseline relative to previous row's baseline + float ymin,ymax; // height of row above and below baseline + int num_chars; +} StbTexteditRow; +#endif //INCLUDE_STB_TEXTEDIT_H + + +//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +//// +//// Implementation mode +//// +//// + + +// implementation isn't include-guarded, since it might have indirectly +// included just the "header" portion +#ifdef STB_TEXTEDIT_IMPLEMENTATION + +#ifndef STB_TEXTEDIT_memmove +#include +#define STB_TEXTEDIT_memmove memmove +#endif + + +///////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +// +// Mouse input handling +// + +// traverse the layout to locate the nearest character to a display position +static int stb_text_locate_coord(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING *str, float x, float y) +{ + StbTexteditRow r; + int n = STB_TEXTEDIT_STRINGLEN(str); + float base_y = 0, prev_x; + int i=0, k; + + r.x0 = r.x1 = 0; + r.ymin = r.ymax = 0; + r.num_chars = 0; + + // search rows to find one that straddles 'y' + while (i < n) { + STB_TEXTEDIT_LAYOUTROW(&r, str, i); + if (r.num_chars <= 0) + return n; + + if (i==0 && y < base_y + r.ymin) + return 0; + + if (y < base_y + r.ymax) + break; + + i += r.num_chars; + base_y += r.baseline_y_delta; + } + + // below all text, return 'after' last character + if (i >= n) + return n; + + // check if it's before the beginning of the line + if (x < r.x0) + return i; + + // check if it's before the end of the line + if (x < r.x1) { + // search characters in row for one that straddles 'x' + prev_x = r.x0; + for (k=0; k < r.num_chars; ++k) { + float w = STB_TEXTEDIT_GETWIDTH(str, i, k); + if (x < prev_x+w) { + if (x < prev_x+w/2) + return k+i; + else + return k+i+1; + } + prev_x += w; + } + // shouldn't happen, but if it does, fall through to end-of-line case + } + + // if the last character is a newline, return that. otherwise return 'after' the last character + if (STB_TEXTEDIT_GETCHAR(str, i+r.num_chars-1) == STB_TEXTEDIT_NEWLINE) + return i+r.num_chars-1; + else + return i+r.num_chars; +} + +// API click: on mouse down, move the cursor to the clicked location, and reset the selection +static void stb_textedit_click(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING *str, STB_TexteditState *state, float x, float y) +{ + // In single-line mode, just always make y = 0. This lets the drag keep working if the mouse + // goes off the top or bottom of the text + if( state->single_line ) + { + StbTexteditRow r; + STB_TEXTEDIT_LAYOUTROW(&r, str, 0); + y = r.ymin; + } + + state->cursor = stb_text_locate_coord(str, x, y); + state->select_start = state->cursor; + state->select_end = state->cursor; + state->has_preferred_x = 0; +} + +// API drag: on mouse drag, move the cursor and selection endpoint to the clicked location +static void stb_textedit_drag(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING *str, STB_TexteditState *state, float x, float y) +{ + int p = 0; + + // In single-line mode, just always make y = 0. This lets the drag keep working if the mouse + // goes off the top or bottom of the text + if( state->single_line ) + { + StbTexteditRow r; + STB_TEXTEDIT_LAYOUTROW(&r, str, 0); + y = r.ymin; + } + + if (state->select_start == state->select_end) + state->select_start = state->cursor; + + p = stb_text_locate_coord(str, x, y); + state->cursor = state->select_end = p; +} + +///////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +// +// Keyboard input handling +// + +// forward declarations +static void stb_text_undo(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING *str, STB_TexteditState *state); +static void stb_text_redo(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING *str, STB_TexteditState *state); +static void stb_text_makeundo_delete(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING *str, STB_TexteditState *state, int where, int length); +static void stb_text_makeundo_insert(STB_TexteditState *state, int where, int length); +static void stb_text_makeundo_replace(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING *str, STB_TexteditState *state, int where, int old_length, int new_length); + +typedef struct +{ + float x,y; // position of n'th character + float height; // height of line + int first_char, length; // first char of row, and length + int prev_first; // first char of previous row +} StbFindState; + +// find the x/y location of a character, and remember info about the previous row in +// case we get a move-up event (for page up, we'll have to rescan) +static void stb_textedit_find_charpos(StbFindState *find, STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING *str, int n, int single_line) +{ + StbTexteditRow r; + int prev_start = 0; + int z = STB_TEXTEDIT_STRINGLEN(str); + int i=0, first; + + if (n == z) { + // if it's at the end, then find the last line -- simpler than trying to + // explicitly handle this case in the regular code + if (single_line) { + STB_TEXTEDIT_LAYOUTROW(&r, str, 0); + find->y = 0; + find->first_char = 0; + find->length = z; + find->height = r.ymax - r.ymin; + find->x = r.x1; + } else { + find->y = 0; + find->x = 0; + find->height = 1; + while (i < z) { + STB_TEXTEDIT_LAYOUTROW(&r, str, i); + prev_start = i; + i += r.num_chars; + } + find->first_char = i; + find->length = 0; + find->prev_first = prev_start; + } + return; + } + + // search rows to find the one that straddles character n + find->y = 0; + + for(;;) { + STB_TEXTEDIT_LAYOUTROW(&r, str, i); + if (n < i + r.num_chars) + break; + prev_start = i; + i += r.num_chars; + find->y += r.baseline_y_delta; + } + + find->first_char = first = i; + find->length = r.num_chars; + find->height = r.ymax - r.ymin; + find->prev_first = prev_start; + + // now scan to find xpos + find->x = r.x0; + for (i=0; first+i < n; ++i) + find->x += STB_TEXTEDIT_GETWIDTH(str, first, i); +} + +#define STB_TEXT_HAS_SELECTION(s) ((s)->select_start != (s)->select_end) + +// make the selection/cursor state valid if client altered the string +static void stb_textedit_clamp(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING *str, STB_TexteditState *state) +{ + int n = STB_TEXTEDIT_STRINGLEN(str); + if (STB_TEXT_HAS_SELECTION(state)) { + if (state->select_start > n) state->select_start = n; + if (state->select_end > n) state->select_end = n; + // if clamping forced them to be equal, move the cursor to match + if (state->select_start == state->select_end) + state->cursor = state->select_start; + } + if (state->cursor > n) state->cursor = n; +} + +// delete characters while updating undo +static void stb_textedit_delete(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING *str, STB_TexteditState *state, int where, int len) +{ + stb_text_makeundo_delete(str, state, where, len); + STB_TEXTEDIT_DELETECHARS(str, where, len); + state->has_preferred_x = 0; +} + +// delete the section +static void stb_textedit_delete_selection(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING *str, STB_TexteditState *state) +{ + stb_textedit_clamp(str, state); + if (STB_TEXT_HAS_SELECTION(state)) { + if (state->select_start < state->select_end) { + stb_textedit_delete(str, state, state->select_start, state->select_end - state->select_start); + state->select_end = state->cursor = state->select_start; + } else { + stb_textedit_delete(str, state, state->select_end, state->select_start - state->select_end); + state->select_start = state->cursor = state->select_end; + } + state->has_preferred_x = 0; + } +} + +// canoncialize the selection so start <= end +static void stb_textedit_sortselection(STB_TexteditState *state) +{ + if (state->select_end < state->select_start) { + int temp = state->select_end; + state->select_end = state->select_start; + state->select_start = temp; + } +} + +// move cursor to first character of selection +static void stb_textedit_move_to_first(STB_TexteditState *state) +{ + if (STB_TEXT_HAS_SELECTION(state)) { + stb_textedit_sortselection(state); + state->cursor = state->select_start; + state->select_end = state->select_start; + state->has_preferred_x = 0; + } +} + +// move cursor to last character of selection +static void stb_textedit_move_to_last(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING *str, STB_TexteditState *state) +{ + if (STB_TEXT_HAS_SELECTION(state)) { + stb_textedit_sortselection(state); + stb_textedit_clamp(str, state); + state->cursor = state->select_end; + state->select_start = state->select_end; + state->has_preferred_x = 0; + } +} + +#ifdef STB_TEXTEDIT_IS_SPACE +static int is_word_boundary( STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING *str, int idx ) +{ + return idx > 0 ? (STB_TEXTEDIT_IS_SPACE( STB_TEXTEDIT_GETCHAR(str,idx-1) ) && !STB_TEXTEDIT_IS_SPACE( STB_TEXTEDIT_GETCHAR(str, idx) ) ) : 1; +} + +#ifndef STB_TEXTEDIT_MOVEWORDLEFT +static int stb_textedit_move_to_word_previous( STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING *str, int c ) +{ + --c; // always move at least one character + while( c >= 0 && !is_word_boundary( str, c ) ) + --c; + + if( c < 0 ) + c = 0; + + return c; +} +#define STB_TEXTEDIT_MOVEWORDLEFT stb_textedit_move_to_word_previous +#endif + +#ifndef STB_TEXTEDIT_MOVEWORDRIGHT +static int stb_textedit_move_to_word_next( STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING *str, int c ) +{ + const int len = STB_TEXTEDIT_STRINGLEN(str); + ++c; // always move at least one character + while( c < len && !is_word_boundary( str, c ) ) + ++c; + + if( c > len ) + c = len; + + return c; +} +#define STB_TEXTEDIT_MOVEWORDRIGHT stb_textedit_move_to_word_next +#endif + +#endif + +// update selection and cursor to match each other +static void stb_textedit_prep_selection_at_cursor(STB_TexteditState *state) +{ + if (!STB_TEXT_HAS_SELECTION(state)) + state->select_start = state->select_end = state->cursor; + else + state->cursor = state->select_end; +} + +// API cut: delete selection +static int stb_textedit_cut(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING *str, STB_TexteditState *state) +{ + if (STB_TEXT_HAS_SELECTION(state)) { + stb_textedit_delete_selection(str,state); // implicitly clamps + state->has_preferred_x = 0; + return 1; + } + return 0; +} + +// API paste: replace existing selection with passed-in text +static int stb_textedit_paste_internal(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING *str, STB_TexteditState *state, STB_TEXTEDIT_CHARTYPE *text, int len) +{ + // if there's a selection, the paste should delete it + stb_textedit_clamp(str, state); + stb_textedit_delete_selection(str,state); + // try to insert the characters + if (STB_TEXTEDIT_INSERTCHARS(str, state->cursor, text, len)) { + stb_text_makeundo_insert(state, state->cursor, len); + state->cursor += len; + state->has_preferred_x = 0; + return 1; + } + // [DEAR IMGUI] + //// remove the undo since we didn't actually insert the characters + //if (state->undostate.undo_point) + // --state->undostate.undo_point; + // note: paste failure will leave deleted selection, may be restored with an undo (see https://github.com/nothings/stb/issues/734 for details) + return 0; +} + +#ifndef STB_TEXTEDIT_KEYTYPE +#define STB_TEXTEDIT_KEYTYPE int +#endif + +// API key: process a keyboard input +static void stb_textedit_key(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING *str, STB_TexteditState *state, STB_TEXTEDIT_KEYTYPE key) +{ +retry: + switch (key) { + default: { + int c = STB_TEXTEDIT_KEYTOTEXT(key); + if (c > 0) { + STB_TEXTEDIT_CHARTYPE ch = (STB_TEXTEDIT_CHARTYPE) c; + + // can't add newline in single-line mode + if (c == '\n' && state->single_line) + break; + + if (state->insert_mode && !STB_TEXT_HAS_SELECTION(state) && state->cursor < STB_TEXTEDIT_STRINGLEN(str)) { + stb_text_makeundo_replace(str, state, state->cursor, 1, 1); + STB_TEXTEDIT_DELETECHARS(str, state->cursor, 1); + if (STB_TEXTEDIT_INSERTCHARS(str, state->cursor, &ch, 1)) { + ++state->cursor; + state->has_preferred_x = 0; + } + } else { + stb_textedit_delete_selection(str,state); // implicitly clamps + if (STB_TEXTEDIT_INSERTCHARS(str, state->cursor, &ch, 1)) { + stb_text_makeundo_insert(state, state->cursor, 1); + ++state->cursor; + state->has_preferred_x = 0; + } + } + } + break; + } + +#ifdef STB_TEXTEDIT_K_INSERT + case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_INSERT: + state->insert_mode = !state->insert_mode; + break; +#endif + + case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_UNDO: + stb_text_undo(str, state); + state->has_preferred_x = 0; + break; + + case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_REDO: + stb_text_redo(str, state); + state->has_preferred_x = 0; + break; + + case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LEFT: + // if currently there's a selection, move cursor to start of selection + if (STB_TEXT_HAS_SELECTION(state)) + stb_textedit_move_to_first(state); + else + if (state->cursor > 0) + --state->cursor; + state->has_preferred_x = 0; + break; + + case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_RIGHT: + // if currently there's a selection, move cursor to end of selection + if (STB_TEXT_HAS_SELECTION(state)) + stb_textedit_move_to_last(str, state); + else + ++state->cursor; + stb_textedit_clamp(str, state); + state->has_preferred_x = 0; + break; + + case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LEFT | STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT: + stb_textedit_clamp(str, state); + stb_textedit_prep_selection_at_cursor(state); + // move selection left + if (state->select_end > 0) + --state->select_end; + state->cursor = state->select_end; + state->has_preferred_x = 0; + break; + +#ifdef STB_TEXTEDIT_MOVEWORDLEFT + case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_WORDLEFT: + if (STB_TEXT_HAS_SELECTION(state)) + stb_textedit_move_to_first(state); + else { + state->cursor = STB_TEXTEDIT_MOVEWORDLEFT(str, state->cursor); + stb_textedit_clamp( str, state ); + } + break; + + case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_WORDLEFT | STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT: + if( !STB_TEXT_HAS_SELECTION( state ) ) + stb_textedit_prep_selection_at_cursor(state); + + state->cursor = STB_TEXTEDIT_MOVEWORDLEFT(str, state->cursor); + state->select_end = state->cursor; + + stb_textedit_clamp( str, state ); + break; +#endif + +#ifdef STB_TEXTEDIT_MOVEWORDRIGHT + case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_WORDRIGHT: + if (STB_TEXT_HAS_SELECTION(state)) + stb_textedit_move_to_last(str, state); + else { + state->cursor = STB_TEXTEDIT_MOVEWORDRIGHT(str, state->cursor); + stb_textedit_clamp( str, state ); + } + break; + + case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_WORDRIGHT | STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT: + if( !STB_TEXT_HAS_SELECTION( state ) ) + stb_textedit_prep_selection_at_cursor(state); + + state->cursor = STB_TEXTEDIT_MOVEWORDRIGHT(str, state->cursor); + state->select_end = state->cursor; + + stb_textedit_clamp( str, state ); + break; +#endif + + case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_RIGHT | STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT: + stb_textedit_prep_selection_at_cursor(state); + // move selection right + ++state->select_end; + stb_textedit_clamp(str, state); + state->cursor = state->select_end; + state->has_preferred_x = 0; + break; + + case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_DOWN: + case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_DOWN | STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT: + case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_PGDOWN: + case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_PGDOWN | STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT: { + StbFindState find; + StbTexteditRow row; + int i, j, sel = (key & STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT) != 0; + int is_page = (key & ~STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT) == STB_TEXTEDIT_K_PGDOWN; + int row_count = is_page ? state->row_count_per_page : 1; + + if (!is_page && state->single_line) { + // on windows, up&down in single-line behave like left&right + key = STB_TEXTEDIT_K_RIGHT | (key & STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT); + goto retry; + } + + if (sel) + stb_textedit_prep_selection_at_cursor(state); + else if (STB_TEXT_HAS_SELECTION(state)) + stb_textedit_move_to_last(str, state); + + // compute current position of cursor point + stb_textedit_clamp(str, state); + stb_textedit_find_charpos(&find, str, state->cursor, state->single_line); + + for (j = 0; j < row_count; ++j) { + float x, goal_x = state->has_preferred_x ? state->preferred_x : find.x; + int start = find.first_char + find.length; + + if (find.length == 0) + break; + + // [DEAR IMGUI] + // going down while being on the last line shouldn't bring us to that line end + if (STB_TEXTEDIT_GETCHAR(str, find.first_char + find.length - 1) != STB_TEXTEDIT_NEWLINE) + break; + + // now find character position down a row + state->cursor = start; + STB_TEXTEDIT_LAYOUTROW(&row, str, state->cursor); + x = row.x0; + for (i=0; i < row.num_chars; ++i) { + float dx = STB_TEXTEDIT_GETWIDTH(str, start, i); + #ifdef STB_TEXTEDIT_GETWIDTH_NEWLINE + if (dx == STB_TEXTEDIT_GETWIDTH_NEWLINE) + break; + #endif + x += dx; + if (x > goal_x) + break; + ++state->cursor; + } + stb_textedit_clamp(str, state); + + state->has_preferred_x = 1; + state->preferred_x = goal_x; + + if (sel) + state->select_end = state->cursor; + + // go to next line + find.first_char = find.first_char + find.length; + find.length = row.num_chars; + } + break; + } + + case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_UP: + case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_UP | STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT: + case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_PGUP: + case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_PGUP | STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT: { + StbFindState find; + StbTexteditRow row; + int i, j, prev_scan, sel = (key & STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT) != 0; + int is_page = (key & ~STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT) == STB_TEXTEDIT_K_PGUP; + int row_count = is_page ? state->row_count_per_page : 1; + + if (!is_page && state->single_line) { + // on windows, up&down become left&right + key = STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LEFT | (key & STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT); + goto retry; + } + + if (sel) + stb_textedit_prep_selection_at_cursor(state); + else if (STB_TEXT_HAS_SELECTION(state)) + stb_textedit_move_to_first(state); + + // compute current position of cursor point + stb_textedit_clamp(str, state); + stb_textedit_find_charpos(&find, str, state->cursor, state->single_line); + + for (j = 0; j < row_count; ++j) { + float x, goal_x = state->has_preferred_x ? state->preferred_x : find.x; + + // can only go up if there's a previous row + if (find.prev_first == find.first_char) + break; + + // now find character position up a row + state->cursor = find.prev_first; + STB_TEXTEDIT_LAYOUTROW(&row, str, state->cursor); + x = row.x0; + for (i=0; i < row.num_chars; ++i) { + float dx = STB_TEXTEDIT_GETWIDTH(str, find.prev_first, i); + #ifdef STB_TEXTEDIT_GETWIDTH_NEWLINE + if (dx == STB_TEXTEDIT_GETWIDTH_NEWLINE) + break; + #endif + x += dx; + if (x > goal_x) + break; + ++state->cursor; + } + stb_textedit_clamp(str, state); + + state->has_preferred_x = 1; + state->preferred_x = goal_x; + + if (sel) + state->select_end = state->cursor; + + // go to previous line + // (we need to scan previous line the hard way. maybe we could expose this as a new API function?) + prev_scan = find.prev_first > 0 ? find.prev_first - 1 : 0; + while (prev_scan > 0 && STB_TEXTEDIT_GETCHAR(str, prev_scan - 1) != STB_TEXTEDIT_NEWLINE) + --prev_scan; + find.first_char = find.prev_first; + find.prev_first = prev_scan; + } + break; + } + + case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_DELETE: + case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_DELETE | STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT: + if (STB_TEXT_HAS_SELECTION(state)) + stb_textedit_delete_selection(str, state); + else { + int n = STB_TEXTEDIT_STRINGLEN(str); + if (state->cursor < n) + stb_textedit_delete(str, state, state->cursor, 1); + } + state->has_preferred_x = 0; + break; + + case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_BACKSPACE: + case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_BACKSPACE | STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT: + if (STB_TEXT_HAS_SELECTION(state)) + stb_textedit_delete_selection(str, state); + else { + stb_textedit_clamp(str, state); + if (state->cursor > 0) { + stb_textedit_delete(str, state, state->cursor-1, 1); + --state->cursor; + } + } + state->has_preferred_x = 0; + break; + +#ifdef STB_TEXTEDIT_K_TEXTSTART2 + case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_TEXTSTART2: +#endif + case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_TEXTSTART: + state->cursor = state->select_start = state->select_end = 0; + state->has_preferred_x = 0; + break; + +#ifdef STB_TEXTEDIT_K_TEXTEND2 + case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_TEXTEND2: +#endif + case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_TEXTEND: + state->cursor = STB_TEXTEDIT_STRINGLEN(str); + state->select_start = state->select_end = 0; + state->has_preferred_x = 0; + break; + +#ifdef STB_TEXTEDIT_K_TEXTSTART2 + case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_TEXTSTART2 | STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT: +#endif + case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_TEXTSTART | STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT: + stb_textedit_prep_selection_at_cursor(state); + state->cursor = state->select_end = 0; + state->has_preferred_x = 0; + break; + +#ifdef STB_TEXTEDIT_K_TEXTEND2 + case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_TEXTEND2 | STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT: +#endif + case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_TEXTEND | STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT: + stb_textedit_prep_selection_at_cursor(state); + state->cursor = state->select_end = STB_TEXTEDIT_STRINGLEN(str); + state->has_preferred_x = 0; + break; + + +#ifdef STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINESTART2 + case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINESTART2: +#endif + case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINESTART: + stb_textedit_clamp(str, state); + stb_textedit_move_to_first(state); + if (state->single_line) + state->cursor = 0; + else while (state->cursor > 0 && STB_TEXTEDIT_GETCHAR(str, state->cursor-1) != STB_TEXTEDIT_NEWLINE) + --state->cursor; + state->has_preferred_x = 0; + break; + +#ifdef STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINEEND2 + case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINEEND2: +#endif + case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINEEND: { + int n = STB_TEXTEDIT_STRINGLEN(str); + stb_textedit_clamp(str, state); + stb_textedit_move_to_first(state); + if (state->single_line) + state->cursor = n; + else while (state->cursor < n && STB_TEXTEDIT_GETCHAR(str, state->cursor) != STB_TEXTEDIT_NEWLINE) + ++state->cursor; + state->has_preferred_x = 0; + break; + } + +#ifdef STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINESTART2 + case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINESTART2 | STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT: +#endif + case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINESTART | STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT: + stb_textedit_clamp(str, state); + stb_textedit_prep_selection_at_cursor(state); + if (state->single_line) + state->cursor = 0; + else while (state->cursor > 0 && STB_TEXTEDIT_GETCHAR(str, state->cursor-1) != STB_TEXTEDIT_NEWLINE) + --state->cursor; + state->select_end = state->cursor; + state->has_preferred_x = 0; + break; + +#ifdef STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINEEND2 + case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINEEND2 | STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT: +#endif + case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINEEND | STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT: { + int n = STB_TEXTEDIT_STRINGLEN(str); + stb_textedit_clamp(str, state); + stb_textedit_prep_selection_at_cursor(state); + if (state->single_line) + state->cursor = n; + else while (state->cursor < n && STB_TEXTEDIT_GETCHAR(str, state->cursor) != STB_TEXTEDIT_NEWLINE) + ++state->cursor; + state->select_end = state->cursor; + state->has_preferred_x = 0; + break; + } + } +} + +///////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +// +// Undo processing +// +// @OPTIMIZE: the undo/redo buffer should be circular + +static void stb_textedit_flush_redo(StbUndoState *state) +{ + state->redo_point = STB_TEXTEDIT_UNDOSTATECOUNT; + state->redo_char_point = STB_TEXTEDIT_UNDOCHARCOUNT; +} + +// discard the oldest entry in the undo list +static void stb_textedit_discard_undo(StbUndoState *state) +{ + if (state->undo_point > 0) { + // if the 0th undo state has characters, clean those up + if (state->undo_rec[0].char_storage >= 0) { + int n = state->undo_rec[0].insert_length, i; + // delete n characters from all other records + state->undo_char_point -= n; + STB_TEXTEDIT_memmove(state->undo_char, state->undo_char + n, (size_t) (state->undo_char_point*sizeof(STB_TEXTEDIT_CHARTYPE))); + for (i=0; i < state->undo_point; ++i) + if (state->undo_rec[i].char_storage >= 0) + state->undo_rec[i].char_storage -= n; // @OPTIMIZE: get rid of char_storage and infer it + } + --state->undo_point; + STB_TEXTEDIT_memmove(state->undo_rec, state->undo_rec+1, (size_t) (state->undo_point*sizeof(state->undo_rec[0]))); + } +} + +// discard the oldest entry in the redo list--it's bad if this +// ever happens, but because undo & redo have to store the actual +// characters in different cases, the redo character buffer can +// fill up even though the undo buffer didn't +static void stb_textedit_discard_redo(StbUndoState *state) +{ + int k = STB_TEXTEDIT_UNDOSTATECOUNT-1; + + if (state->redo_point <= k) { + // if the k'th undo state has characters, clean those up + if (state->undo_rec[k].char_storage >= 0) { + int n = state->undo_rec[k].insert_length, i; + // move the remaining redo character data to the end of the buffer + state->redo_char_point += n; + STB_TEXTEDIT_memmove(state->undo_char + state->redo_char_point, state->undo_char + state->redo_char_point-n, (size_t) ((STB_TEXTEDIT_UNDOCHARCOUNT - state->redo_char_point)*sizeof(STB_TEXTEDIT_CHARTYPE))); + // adjust the position of all the other records to account for above memmove + for (i=state->redo_point; i < k; ++i) + if (state->undo_rec[i].char_storage >= 0) + state->undo_rec[i].char_storage += n; + } + // now move all the redo records towards the end of the buffer; the first one is at 'redo_point' + // [DEAR IMGUI] + size_t move_size = (size_t)((STB_TEXTEDIT_UNDOSTATECOUNT - state->redo_point - 1) * sizeof(state->undo_rec[0])); + const char* buf_begin = (char*)state->undo_rec; (void)buf_begin; + const char* buf_end = (char*)state->undo_rec + sizeof(state->undo_rec); (void)buf_end; + IM_ASSERT(((char*)(state->undo_rec + state->redo_point)) >= buf_begin); + IM_ASSERT(((char*)(state->undo_rec + state->redo_point + 1) + move_size) <= buf_end); + STB_TEXTEDIT_memmove(state->undo_rec + state->redo_point+1, state->undo_rec + state->redo_point, move_size); + + // now move redo_point to point to the new one + ++state->redo_point; + } +} + +static StbUndoRecord *stb_text_create_undo_record(StbUndoState *state, int numchars) +{ + // any time we create a new undo record, we discard redo + stb_textedit_flush_redo(state); + + // if we have no free records, we have to make room, by sliding the + // existing records down + if (state->undo_point == STB_TEXTEDIT_UNDOSTATECOUNT) + stb_textedit_discard_undo(state); + + // if the characters to store won't possibly fit in the buffer, we can't undo + if (numchars > STB_TEXTEDIT_UNDOCHARCOUNT) { + state->undo_point = 0; + state->undo_char_point = 0; + return NULL; + } + + // if we don't have enough free characters in the buffer, we have to make room + while (state->undo_char_point + numchars > STB_TEXTEDIT_UNDOCHARCOUNT) + stb_textedit_discard_undo(state); + + return &state->undo_rec[state->undo_point++]; +} + +static STB_TEXTEDIT_CHARTYPE *stb_text_createundo(StbUndoState *state, int pos, int insert_len, int delete_len) +{ + StbUndoRecord *r = stb_text_create_undo_record(state, insert_len); + if (r == NULL) + return NULL; + + r->where = pos; + r->insert_length = (STB_TEXTEDIT_POSITIONTYPE) insert_len; + r->delete_length = (STB_TEXTEDIT_POSITIONTYPE) delete_len; + + if (insert_len == 0) { + r->char_storage = -1; + return NULL; + } else { + r->char_storage = state->undo_char_point; + state->undo_char_point += insert_len; + return &state->undo_char[r->char_storage]; + } +} + +static void stb_text_undo(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING *str, STB_TexteditState *state) +{ + StbUndoState *s = &state->undostate; + StbUndoRecord u, *r; + if (s->undo_point == 0) + return; + + // we need to do two things: apply the undo record, and create a redo record + u = s->undo_rec[s->undo_point-1]; + r = &s->undo_rec[s->redo_point-1]; + r->char_storage = -1; + + r->insert_length = u.delete_length; + r->delete_length = u.insert_length; + r->where = u.where; + + if (u.delete_length) { + // if the undo record says to delete characters, then the redo record will + // need to re-insert the characters that get deleted, so we need to store + // them. + + // there are three cases: + // there's enough room to store the characters + // characters stored for *redoing* don't leave room for redo + // characters stored for *undoing* don't leave room for redo + // if the last is true, we have to bail + + if (s->undo_char_point + u.delete_length >= STB_TEXTEDIT_UNDOCHARCOUNT) { + // the undo records take up too much character space; there's no space to store the redo characters + r->insert_length = 0; + } else { + int i; + + // there's definitely room to store the characters eventually + while (s->undo_char_point + u.delete_length > s->redo_char_point) { + // should never happen: + if (s->redo_point == STB_TEXTEDIT_UNDOSTATECOUNT) + return; + // there's currently not enough room, so discard a redo record + stb_textedit_discard_redo(s); + } + r = &s->undo_rec[s->redo_point-1]; + + r->char_storage = s->redo_char_point - u.delete_length; + s->redo_char_point = s->redo_char_point - u.delete_length; + + // now save the characters + for (i=0; i < u.delete_length; ++i) + s->undo_char[r->char_storage + i] = STB_TEXTEDIT_GETCHAR(str, u.where + i); + } + + // now we can carry out the deletion + STB_TEXTEDIT_DELETECHARS(str, u.where, u.delete_length); + } + + // check type of recorded action: + if (u.insert_length) { + // easy case: was a deletion, so we need to insert n characters + STB_TEXTEDIT_INSERTCHARS(str, u.where, &s->undo_char[u.char_storage], u.insert_length); + s->undo_char_point -= u.insert_length; + } + + state->cursor = u.where + u.insert_length; + + s->undo_point--; + s->redo_point--; +} + +static void stb_text_redo(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING *str, STB_TexteditState *state) +{ + StbUndoState *s = &state->undostate; + StbUndoRecord *u, r; + if (s->redo_point == STB_TEXTEDIT_UNDOSTATECOUNT) + return; + + // we need to do two things: apply the redo record, and create an undo record + u = &s->undo_rec[s->undo_point]; + r = s->undo_rec[s->redo_point]; + + // we KNOW there must be room for the undo record, because the redo record + // was derived from an undo record + + u->delete_length = r.insert_length; + u->insert_length = r.delete_length; + u->where = r.where; + u->char_storage = -1; + + if (r.delete_length) { + // the redo record requires us to delete characters, so the undo record + // needs to store the characters + + if (s->undo_char_point + u->insert_length > s->redo_char_point) { + u->insert_length = 0; + u->delete_length = 0; + } else { + int i; + u->char_storage = s->undo_char_point; + s->undo_char_point = s->undo_char_point + u->insert_length; + + // now save the characters + for (i=0; i < u->insert_length; ++i) + s->undo_char[u->char_storage + i] = STB_TEXTEDIT_GETCHAR(str, u->where + i); + } + + STB_TEXTEDIT_DELETECHARS(str, r.where, r.delete_length); + } + + if (r.insert_length) { + // easy case: need to insert n characters + STB_TEXTEDIT_INSERTCHARS(str, r.where, &s->undo_char[r.char_storage], r.insert_length); + s->redo_char_point += r.insert_length; + } + + state->cursor = r.where + r.insert_length; + + s->undo_point++; + s->redo_point++; +} + +static void stb_text_makeundo_insert(STB_TexteditState *state, int where, int length) +{ + stb_text_createundo(&state->undostate, where, 0, length); +} + +static void stb_text_makeundo_delete(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING *str, STB_TexteditState *state, int where, int length) +{ + int i; + STB_TEXTEDIT_CHARTYPE *p = stb_text_createundo(&state->undostate, where, length, 0); + if (p) { + for (i=0; i < length; ++i) + p[i] = STB_TEXTEDIT_GETCHAR(str, where+i); + } +} + +static void stb_text_makeundo_replace(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING *str, STB_TexteditState *state, int where, int old_length, int new_length) +{ + int i; + STB_TEXTEDIT_CHARTYPE *p = stb_text_createundo(&state->undostate, where, old_length, new_length); + if (p) { + for (i=0; i < old_length; ++i) + p[i] = STB_TEXTEDIT_GETCHAR(str, where+i); + } +} + +// reset the state to default +static void stb_textedit_clear_state(STB_TexteditState *state, int is_single_line) +{ + state->undostate.undo_point = 0; + state->undostate.undo_char_point = 0; + state->undostate.redo_point = STB_TEXTEDIT_UNDOSTATECOUNT; + state->undostate.redo_char_point = STB_TEXTEDIT_UNDOCHARCOUNT; + state->select_end = state->select_start = 0; + state->cursor = 0; + state->has_preferred_x = 0; + state->preferred_x = 0; + state->cursor_at_end_of_line = 0; + state->initialized = 1; + state->single_line = (unsigned char) is_single_line; + state->insert_mode = 0; + state->row_count_per_page = 0; +} + +// API initialize +static void stb_textedit_initialize_state(STB_TexteditState *state, int is_single_line) +{ + stb_textedit_clear_state(state, is_single_line); +} + +#if defined(__GNUC__) || defined(__clang__) +#pragma GCC diagnostic push +#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wcast-qual" +#endif + +static int stb_textedit_paste(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING *str, STB_TexteditState *state, STB_TEXTEDIT_CHARTYPE const *ctext, int len) +{ + return stb_textedit_paste_internal(str, state, (STB_TEXTEDIT_CHARTYPE *) ctext, len); +} + +#if defined(__GNUC__) || defined(__clang__) +#pragma GCC diagnostic pop +#endif + +#endif//STB_TEXTEDIT_IMPLEMENTATION + +/* +------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +This software is available under 2 licenses -- choose whichever you prefer. +------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +ALTERNATIVE A - MIT License +Copyright (c) 2017 Sean Barrett +Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy of +this software and associated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal in +the Software without restriction, including without limitation the rights to +use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies +of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do +so, subject to the following conditions: +The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in all +copies or substantial portions of the Software. +THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR +IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, +FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE +AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER +LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, +OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE +SOFTWARE. +------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +ALTERNATIVE B - Public Domain (www.unlicense.org) +This is free and unencumbered software released into the public domain. +Anyone is free to copy, modify, publish, use, compile, sell, or distribute this +software, either in source code form or as a compiled binary, for any purpose, +commercial or non-commercial, and by any means. +In jurisdictions that recognize copyright laws, the author or authors of this +software dedicate any and all copyright interest in the software to the public +domain. We make this dedication for the benefit of the public at large and to +the detriment of our heirs and successors. We intend this dedication to be an +overt act of relinquishment in perpetuity of all present and future rights to +this software under copyright law. +THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR +IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, +FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE +AUTHORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN +ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION +WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. +------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +*/ diff --git a/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/imgui-1.84.2/imstb_truetype.h b/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/imgui-1.84.2/imstb_truetype.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000..48c2026 --- /dev/null +++ b/3rdparty/imnodes/dependencies/imgui-1.84.2/imstb_truetype.h @@ -0,0 +1,4903 @@ +// [DEAR IMGUI] +// This is a slightly modified version of stb_truetype.h 1.20. +// Mostly fixing for compiler and static analyzer warnings. +// Grep for [DEAR IMGUI] to find the changes. + +// stb_truetype.h - v1.20 - public domain +// authored from 2009-2016 by Sean Barrett / RAD Game Tools +// +// This library processes TrueType files: +// parse files +// extract glyph metrics +// extract glyph shapes +// render glyphs to one-channel bitmaps with antialiasing (box filter) +// render glyphs to one-channel SDF bitmaps (signed-distance field/function) +// +// Todo: +// non-MS cmaps +// crashproof on bad data +// hinting? (no longer patented) +// cleartype-style AA? +// optimize: use simple memory allocator for intermediates +// optimize: build edge-list directly from curves +// optimize: rasterize directly from curves? +// +// ADDITIONAL CONTRIBUTORS +// +// Mikko Mononen: compound shape support, more cmap formats +// Tor Andersson: kerning, subpixel rendering +// Dougall Johnson: OpenType / Type 2 font handling +// Daniel Ribeiro Maciel: basic GPOS-based kerning +// +// Misc other: +// Ryan Gordon +// Simon Glass +// github:IntellectualKitty +// Imanol Celaya +// Daniel Ribeiro Maciel +// +// Bug/warning reports/fixes: +// "Zer" on mollyrocket Fabian "ryg" Giesen +// Cass Everitt Martins Mozeiko +// stoiko (Haemimont Games) Cap Petschulat +// Brian Hook Omar Cornut +// Walter van Niftrik github:aloucks +// David Gow Peter LaValle +// David Given Sergey Popov +// Ivan-Assen Ivanov Giumo X. Clanjor +// Anthony Pesch Higor Euripedes +// Johan Duparc Thomas Fields +// Hou Qiming Derek Vinyard +// Rob Loach Cort Stratton +// Kenney Phillis Jr. github:oyvindjam +// Brian Costabile github:vassvik +// +// VERSION HISTORY +// +// 1.20 (2019-02-07) PackFontRange skips missing codepoints; GetScaleFontVMetrics() +// 1.19 (2018-02-11) GPOS kerning, STBTT_fmod +// 1.18 (2018-01-29) add missing function +// 1.17 (2017-07-23) make more arguments const; doc fix +// 1.16 (2017-07-12) SDF support +// 1.15 (2017-03-03) make more arguments const +// 1.14 (2017-01-16) num-fonts-in-TTC function +// 1.13 (2017-01-02) support OpenType fonts, certain Apple fonts +// 1.12 (2016-10-25) suppress warnings about casting away const with -Wcast-qual +// 1.11 (2016-04-02) fix unused-variable warning +// 1.10 (2016-04-02) user-defined fabs(); rare memory leak; remove duplicate typedef +// 1.09 (2016-01-16) warning fix; avoid crash on outofmem; use allocation userdata properly +// 1.08 (2015-09-13) document stbtt_Rasterize(); fixes for vertical & horizontal edges +// 1.07 (2015-08-01) allow PackFontRanges to accept arrays of sparse codepoints; +// variant PackFontRanges to pack and render in separate phases; +// fix stbtt_GetFontOFfsetForIndex (never worked for non-0 input?); +// fixed an assert() bug in the new rasterizer +// replace assert() with STBTT_assert() in new rasterizer +// +// Full history can be found at the end of this file. +// +// LICENSE +// +// See end of file for license information. +// +// USAGE +// +// Include this file in whatever places need to refer to it. In ONE C/C++ +// file, write: +// #define STB_TRUETYPE_IMPLEMENTATION +// before the #include of this file. This expands out the actual +// implementation into that C/C++ file. +// +// To make the implementation private to the file that generates the implementation, +// #define STBTT_STATIC +// +// Simple 3D API (don't ship this, but it's fine for tools and quick start) +// stbtt_BakeFontBitmap() -- bake a font to a bitmap for use as texture +// stbtt_GetBakedQuad() -- compute quad to draw for a given char +// +// Improved 3D API (more shippable): +// #include "stb_rect_pack.h" -- optional, but you really want it +// stbtt_PackBegin() +// stbtt_PackSetOversampling() -- for improved quality on small fonts +// stbtt_PackFontRanges() -- pack and renders +// stbtt_PackEnd() +// stbtt_GetPackedQuad() +// +// "Load" a font file from a memory buffer (you have to keep the buffer loaded) +// stbtt_InitFont() +// stbtt_GetFontOffsetForIndex() -- indexing for TTC font collections +// stbtt_GetNumberOfFonts() -- number of fonts for TTC font collections +// +// Render a unicode codepoint to a bitmap +// stbtt_GetCodepointBitmap() -- allocates and returns a bitmap +// stbtt_MakeCodepointBitmap() -- renders into bitmap you provide +// stbtt_GetCodepointBitmapBox() -- how big the bitmap must be +// +// Character advance/positioning +// stbtt_GetCodepointHMetrics() +// stbtt_GetFontVMetrics() +// stbtt_GetFontVMetricsOS2() +// stbtt_GetCodepointKernAdvance() +// +// Starting with version 1.06, the rasterizer was replaced with a new, +// faster and generally-more-precise rasterizer. The new rasterizer more +// accurately measures pixel coverage for anti-aliasing, except in the case +// where multiple shapes overlap, in which case it overestimates the AA pixel +// coverage. Thus, anti-aliasing of intersecting shapes may look wrong. If +// this turns out to be a problem, you can re-enable the old rasterizer with +// #define STBTT_RASTERIZER_VERSION 1 +// which will incur about a 15% speed hit. +// +// ADDITIONAL DOCUMENTATION +// +// Immediately after this block comment are a series of sample programs. +// +// After the sample programs is the "header file" section. This section +// includes documentation for each API function. +// +// Some important concepts to understand to use this library: +// +// Codepoint +// Characters are defined by unicode codepoints, e.g. 65 is +// uppercase A, 231 is lowercase c with a cedilla, 0x7e30 is +// the hiragana for "ma". +// +// Glyph +// A visual character shape (every codepoint is rendered as +// some glyph) +// +// Glyph index +// A font-specific integer ID representing a glyph +// +// Baseline +// Glyph shapes are defined relative to a baseline, which is the +// bottom of uppercase characters. Characters extend both above +// and below the baseline. +// +// Current Point +// As you draw text to the screen, you keep track of a "current point" +// which is the origin of each character. The current point's vertical +// position is the baseline. Even "baked fonts" use this model. +// +// Vertical Font Metrics +// The vertical qualities of the font, used to vertically position +// and space the characters. See docs for stbtt_GetFontVMetrics. +// +// Font Size in Pixels or Points +// The preferred interface for specifying font sizes in stb_truetype +// is to specify how tall the font's vertical extent should be in pixels. +// If that sounds good enough, skip the next paragraph. +// +// Most font APIs instead use "points", which are a common typographic +// measurement for describing font size, defined as 72 points per inch. +// stb_truetype provides a point API for compatibility. However, true +// "per inch" conventions don't make much sense on computer displays +// since different monitors have different number of pixels per +// inch. For example, Windows traditionally uses a convention that +// there are 96 pixels per inch, thus making 'inch' measurements have +// nothing to do with inches, and thus effectively defining a point to +// be 1.333 pixels. Additionally, the TrueType font data provides +// an explicit scale factor to scale a given font's glyphs to points, +// but the author has observed that this scale factor is often wrong +// for non-commercial fonts, thus making fonts scaled in points +// according to the TrueType spec incoherently sized in practice. +// +// DETAILED USAGE: +// +// Scale: +// Select how high you want the font to be, in points or pixels. +// Call ScaleForPixelHeight or ScaleForMappingEmToPixels to compute +// a scale factor SF that will be used by all other functions. +// +// Baseline: +// You need to select a y-coordinate that is the baseline of where +// your text will appear. Call GetFontBoundingBox to get the baseline-relative +// bounding box for all characters. SF*-y0 will be the distance in pixels +// that the worst-case character could extend above the baseline, so if +// you want the top edge of characters to appear at the top of the +// screen where y=0, then you would set the baseline to SF*-y0. +// +// Current point: +// Set the current point where the first character will appear. The +// first character could extend left of the current point; this is font +// dependent. You can either choose a current point that is the leftmost +// point and hope, or add some padding, or check the bounding box or +// left-side-bearing of the first character to be displayed and set +// the current point based on that. +// +// Displaying a character: +// Compute the bounding box of the character. It will contain signed values +// relative to . I.e. if it returns x0,y0,x1,y1, +// then the character should be displayed in the rectangle from +// to = 32 && *text < 128) { + stbtt_aligned_quad q; + stbtt_GetBakedQuad(cdata, 512,512, *text-32, &x,&y,&q,1);//1=opengl & d3d10+,0=d3d9 + glTexCoord2f(q.s0,q.t1); glVertex2f(q.x0,q.y0); + glTexCoord2f(q.s1,q.t1); glVertex2f(q.x1,q.y0); + glTexCoord2f(q.s1,q.t0); glVertex2f(q.x1,q.y1); + glTexCoord2f(q.s0,q.t0); glVertex2f(q.x0,q.y1); + } + ++text; + } + glEnd(); +} +#endif +// +// +////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +// +// Complete program (this compiles): get a single bitmap, print as ASCII art +// +#if 0 +#include +#define STB_TRUETYPE_IMPLEMENTATION // force following include to generate implementation +#include "stb_truetype.h" + +char ttf_buffer[1<<25]; + +int main(int argc, char **argv) +{ + stbtt_fontinfo font; + unsigned char *bitmap; + int w,h,i,j,c = (argc > 1 ? atoi(argv[1]) : 'a'), s = (argc > 2 ? atoi(argv[2]) : 20); + + fread(ttf_buffer, 1, 1<<25, fopen(argc > 3 ? argv[3] : "c:/windows/fonts/arialbd.ttf", "rb")); + + stbtt_InitFont(&font, ttf_buffer, stbtt_GetFontOffsetForIndex(ttf_buffer,0)); + bitmap = stbtt_GetCodepointBitmap(&font, 0,stbtt_ScaleForPixelHeight(&font, s), c, &w, &h, 0,0); + + for (j=0; j < h; ++j) { + for (i=0; i < w; ++i) + putchar(" .:ioVM@"[bitmap[j*w+i]>>5]); + putchar('\n'); + } + return 0; +} +#endif +// +// Output: +// +// .ii. +// @@@@@@. +// V@Mio@@o +// :i. V@V +// :oM@@M +// :@@@MM@M +// @@o o@M +// :@@. M@M +// @@@o@@@@ +// :M@@V:@@. +// +////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +// +// Complete program: print "Hello World!" banner, with bugs +// +#if 0 +char buffer[24<<20]; +unsigned char screen[20][79]; + +int main(int arg, char **argv) +{ + stbtt_fontinfo font; + int i,j,ascent,baseline,ch=0; + float scale, xpos=2; // leave a little padding in case the character extends left + char *text = "Heljo World!"; // intentionally misspelled to show 'lj' brokenness + + fread(buffer, 1, 1000000, fopen("c:/windows/fonts/arialbd.ttf", "rb")); + stbtt_InitFont(&font, buffer, 0); + + scale = stbtt_ScaleForPixelHeight(&font, 15); + stbtt_GetFontVMetrics(&font, &ascent,0,0); + baseline = (int) (ascent*scale); + + while (text[ch]) { + int advance,lsb,x0,y0,x1,y1; + float x_shift = xpos - (float) floor(xpos); + stbtt_GetCodepointHMetrics(&font, text[ch], &advance, &lsb); + stbtt_GetCodepointBitmapBoxSubpixel(&font, text[ch], scale,scale,x_shift,0, &x0,&y0,&x1,&y1); + stbtt_MakeCodepointBitmapSubpixel(&font, &screen[baseline + y0][(int) xpos + x0], x1-x0,y1-y0, 79, scale,scale,x_shift,0, text[ch]); + // note that this stomps the old data, so where character boxes overlap (e.g. 'lj') it's wrong + // because this API is really for baking character bitmaps into textures. if you want to render + // a sequence of characters, you really need to render each bitmap to a temp buffer, then + // "alpha blend" that into the working buffer + xpos += (advance * scale); + if (text[ch+1]) + xpos += scale*stbtt_GetCodepointKernAdvance(&font, text[ch],text[ch+1]); + ++ch; + } + + for (j=0; j < 20; ++j) { + for (i=0; i < 78; ++i) + putchar(" .:ioVM@"[screen[j][i]>>5]); + putchar('\n'); + } + + return 0; +} +#endif + + +////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +//// +//// INTEGRATION WITH YOUR CODEBASE +//// +//// The following sections allow you to supply alternate definitions +//// of C library functions used by stb_truetype, e.g. if you don't +//// link with the C runtime library. + +#ifdef STB_TRUETYPE_IMPLEMENTATION + // #define your own (u)stbtt_int8/16/32 before including to override this + #ifndef stbtt_uint8 + typedef unsigned char stbtt_uint8; + typedef signed char stbtt_int8; + typedef unsigned short stbtt_uint16; + typedef signed short stbtt_int16; + typedef unsigned int stbtt_uint32; + typedef signed int stbtt_int32; + #endif + + typedef char stbtt__check_size32[sizeof(stbtt_int32)==4 ? 1 : -1]; + typedef char stbtt__check_size16[sizeof(stbtt_int16)==2 ? 1 : -1]; + + // e.g. #define your own STBTT_ifloor/STBTT_iceil() to avoid math.h + #ifndef STBTT_ifloor + #include + #define STBTT_ifloor(x) ((int) floor(x)) + #define STBTT_iceil(x) ((int) ceil(x)) + #endif + + #ifndef STBTT_sqrt + #include + #define STBTT_sqrt(x) sqrt(x) + #define STBTT_pow(x,y) pow(x,y) + #endif + + #ifndef STBTT_fmod + #include + #define STBTT_fmod(x,y) fmod(x,y) + #endif + + #ifndef STBTT_cos + #include + #define STBTT_cos(x) cos(x) + #define STBTT_acos(x) acos(x) + #endif + + #ifndef STBTT_fabs + #include + #define STBTT_fabs(x) fabs(x) + #endif + + // #define your own functions "STBTT_malloc" / "STBTT_free" to avoid malloc.h + #ifndef STBTT_malloc + #include + #define STBTT_malloc(x,u) ((void)(u),malloc(x)) + #define STBTT_free(x,u) ((void)(u),free(x)) + #endif + + #ifndef STBTT_assert + #include + #define STBTT_assert(x) assert(x) + #endif + + #ifndef STBTT_strlen + #include + #define STBTT_strlen(x) strlen(x) + #endif + + #ifndef STBTT_memcpy + #include + #define STBTT_memcpy memcpy + #define STBTT_memset memset + #endif +#endif + +/////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +/////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +//// +//// INTERFACE +//// +//// + +#ifndef __STB_INCLUDE_STB_TRUETYPE_H__ +#define __STB_INCLUDE_STB_TRUETYPE_H__ + +#ifdef STBTT_STATIC +#define STBTT_DEF static +#else +#define STBTT_DEF extern +#endif + +#ifdef __cplusplus +extern "C" { +#endif + +// private structure +typedef struct +{ + unsigned char *data; + int cursor; + int size; +} stbtt__buf; + +////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +// +// TEXTURE BAKING API +// +// If you use this API, you only have to call two functions ever. +// + +typedef struct +{ + unsigned short x0,y0,x1,y1; // coordinates of bbox in bitmap + float xoff,yoff,xadvance; +} stbtt_bakedchar; + +STBTT_DEF int stbtt_BakeFontBitmap(const unsigned char *data, int offset, // font location (use offset=0 for plain .ttf) + float pixel_height, // height of font in pixels + unsigned char *pixels, int pw, int ph, // bitmap to be filled in + int first_char, int num_chars, // characters to bake + stbtt_bakedchar *chardata); // you allocate this, it's num_chars long +// if return is positive, the first unused row of the bitmap +// if return is negative, returns the negative of the number of characters that fit +// if return is 0, no characters fit and no rows were used +// This uses a very crappy packing. + +typedef struct +{ + float x0,y0,s0,t0; // top-left + float x1,y1,s1,t1; // bottom-right +} stbtt_aligned_quad; + +STBTT_DEF void stbtt_GetBakedQuad(const stbtt_bakedchar *chardata, int pw, int ph, // same data as above + int char_index, // character to display + float *xpos, float *ypos, // pointers to current position in screen pixel space + stbtt_aligned_quad *q, // output: quad to draw + int opengl_fillrule); // true if opengl fill rule; false if DX9 or earlier +// Call GetBakedQuad with char_index = 'character - first_char', and it +// creates the quad you need to draw and advances the current position. +// +// The coordinate system used assumes y increases downwards. +// +// Characters will extend both above and below the current position; +// see discussion of "BASELINE" above. +// +// It's inefficient; you might want to c&p it and optimize it. + +STBTT_DEF void stbtt_GetScaledFontVMetrics(const unsigned char *fontdata, int index, float size, float *ascent, float *descent, float *lineGap); +// Query the font vertical metrics without having to create a font first. + + +////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +// +// NEW TEXTURE BAKING API +// +// This provides options for packing multiple fonts into one atlas, not +// perfectly but better than nothing. + +typedef struct +{ + unsigned short x0,y0,x1,y1; // coordinates of bbox in bitmap + float xoff,yoff,xadvance; + float xoff2,yoff2; +} stbtt_packedchar; + +typedef struct stbtt_pack_context stbtt_pack_context; +typedef struct stbtt_fontinfo stbtt_fontinfo; +#ifndef STB_RECT_PACK_VERSION +typedef struct stbrp_rect stbrp_rect; +#endif + +STBTT_DEF int stbtt_PackBegin(stbtt_pack_context *spc, unsigned char *pixels, int width, int height, int stride_in_bytes, int padding, void *alloc_context); +// Initializes a packing context stored in the passed-in stbtt_pack_context. +// Future calls using this context will pack characters into the bitmap passed +// in here: a 1-channel bitmap that is width * height. stride_in_bytes is +// the distance from one row to the next (or 0 to mean they are packed tightly +// together). "padding" is the amount of padding to leave between each +// character (normally you want '1' for bitmaps you'll use as textures with +// bilinear filtering). +// +// Returns 0 on failure, 1 on success. + +STBTT_DEF void stbtt_PackEnd (stbtt_pack_context *spc); +// Cleans up the packing context and frees all memory. + +#define STBTT_POINT_SIZE(x) (-(x)) + +STBTT_DEF int stbtt_PackFontRange(stbtt_pack_context *spc, const unsigned char *fontdata, int font_index, float font_size, + int first_unicode_char_in_range, int num_chars_in_range, stbtt_packedchar *chardata_for_range); +// Creates character bitmaps from the font_index'th font found in fontdata (use +// font_index=0 if you don't know what that is). It creates num_chars_in_range +// bitmaps for characters with unicode values starting at first_unicode_char_in_range +// and increasing. Data for how to render them is stored in chardata_for_range; +// pass these to stbtt_GetPackedQuad to get back renderable quads. +// +// font_size is the full height of the character from ascender to descender, +// as computed by stbtt_ScaleForPixelHeight. To use a point size as computed +// by stbtt_ScaleForMappingEmToPixels, wrap the point size in STBTT_POINT_SIZE() +// and pass that result as 'font_size': +// ..., 20 , ... // font max minus min y is 20 pixels tall +// ..., STBTT_POINT_SIZE(20), ... // 'M' is 20 pixels tall + +typedef struct +{ + float font_size; + int first_unicode_codepoint_in_range; // if non-zero, then the chars are continuous, and this is the first codepoint + int *array_of_unicode_codepoints; // if non-zero, then this is an array of unicode codepoints + int num_chars; + stbtt_packedchar *chardata_for_range; // output + unsigned char h_oversample, v_oversample; // don't set these, they're used internally +} stbtt_pack_range; + +STBTT_DEF int stbtt_PackFontRanges(stbtt_pack_context *spc, const unsigned char *fontdata, int font_index, stbtt_pack_range *ranges, int num_ranges); +// Creates character bitmaps from multiple ranges of characters stored in +// ranges. This will usually create a better-packed bitmap than multiple +// calls to stbtt_PackFontRange. Note that you can call this multiple +// times within a single PackBegin/PackEnd. + +STBTT_DEF void stbtt_PackSetOversampling(stbtt_pack_context *spc, unsigned int h_oversample, unsigned int v_oversample); +// Oversampling a font increases the quality by allowing higher-quality subpixel +// positioning, and is especially valuable at smaller text sizes. +// +// This function sets the amount of oversampling for all following calls to +// stbtt_PackFontRange(s) or stbtt_PackFontRangesGatherRects for a given +// pack context. The default (no oversampling) is achieved by h_oversample=1 +// and v_oversample=1. The total number of pixels required is +// h_oversample*v_oversample larger than the default; for example, 2x2 +// oversampling requires 4x the storage of 1x1. For best results, render +// oversampled textures with bilinear filtering. Look at the readme in +// stb/tests/oversample for information about oversampled fonts +// +// To use with PackFontRangesGather etc., you must set it before calls +// call to PackFontRangesGatherRects. + +STBTT_DEF void stbtt_PackSetSkipMissingCodepoints(stbtt_pack_context *spc, int skip); +// If skip != 0, this tells stb_truetype to skip any codepoints for which +// there is no corresponding glyph. If skip=0, which is the default, then +// codepoints without a glyph recived the font's "missing character" glyph, +// typically an empty box by convention. + +STBTT_DEF void stbtt_GetPackedQuad(const stbtt_packedchar *chardata, int pw, int ph, // same data as above + int char_index, // character to display + float *xpos, float *ypos, // pointers to current position in screen pixel space + stbtt_aligned_quad *q, // output: quad to draw + int align_to_integer); + +STBTT_DEF int stbtt_PackFontRangesGatherRects(stbtt_pack_context *spc, const stbtt_fontinfo *info, stbtt_pack_range *ranges, int num_ranges, stbrp_rect *rects); +STBTT_DEF void stbtt_PackFontRangesPackRects(stbtt_pack_context *spc, stbrp_rect *rects, int num_rects); +STBTT_DEF int stbtt_PackFontRangesRenderIntoRects(stbtt_pack_context *spc, const stbtt_fontinfo *info, stbtt_pack_range *ranges, int num_ranges, stbrp_rect *rects); +// Calling these functions in sequence is roughly equivalent to calling +// stbtt_PackFontRanges(). If you more control over the packing of multiple +// fonts, or if you want to pack custom data into a font texture, take a look +// at the source to of stbtt_PackFontRanges() and create a custom version +// using these functions, e.g. call GatherRects multiple times, +// building up a single array of rects, then call PackRects once, +// then call RenderIntoRects repeatedly. This may result in a +// better packing than calling PackFontRanges multiple times +// (or it may not). + +// this is an opaque structure that you shouldn't mess with which holds +// all the context needed from PackBegin to PackEnd. +struct stbtt_pack_context { + void *user_allocator_context; + void *pack_info; + int width; + int height; + int stride_in_bytes; + int padding; + int skip_missing; + unsigned int h_oversample, v_oversample; + unsigned char *pixels; + void *nodes; +}; + +////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +// +// FONT LOADING +// +// + +STBTT_DEF int stbtt_GetNumberOfFonts(const unsigned char *data); +// This function will determine the number of fonts in a font file. TrueType +// collection (.ttc) files may contain multiple fonts, while TrueType font +// (.ttf) files only contain one font. The number of fonts can be used for +// indexing with the previous function where the index is between zero and one +// less than the total fonts. If an error occurs, -1 is returned. + +STBTT_DEF int stbtt_GetFontOffsetForIndex(const unsigned char *data, int index); +// Each .ttf/.ttc file may have more than one font. Each font has a sequential +// index number starting from 0. Call this function to get the font offset for +// a given index; it returns -1 if the index is out of range. A regular .ttf +// file will only define one font and it always be at offset 0, so it will +// return '0' for index 0, and -1 for all other indices. + +// The following structure is defined publicly so you can declare one on +// the stack or as a global or etc, but you should treat it as opaque. +struct stbtt_fontinfo +{ + void * userdata; + unsigned char * data; // pointer to .ttf file + int fontstart; // offset of start of font + + int numGlyphs; // number of glyphs, needed for range checking + + int loca,head,glyf,hhea,hmtx,kern,gpos; // table locations as offset from start of .ttf + int index_map; // a cmap mapping for our chosen character encoding + int indexToLocFormat; // format needed to map from glyph index to glyph + + stbtt__buf cff; // cff font data + stbtt__buf charstrings; // the charstring index + stbtt__buf gsubrs; // global charstring subroutines index + stbtt__buf subrs; // private charstring subroutines index + stbtt__buf fontdicts; // array of font dicts + stbtt__buf fdselect; // map from glyph to fontdict +}; + +STBTT_DEF int stbtt_InitFont(stbtt_fontinfo *info, const unsigned char *data, int offset); +// Given an offset into the file that defines a font, this function builds +// the necessary cached info for the rest of the system. You must allocate +// the stbtt_fontinfo yourself, and stbtt_InitFont will fill it out. You don't +// need to do anything special to free it, because the contents are pure +// value data with no additional data structures. Returns 0 on failure. + + +////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +// +// CHARACTER TO GLYPH-INDEX CONVERSIOn + +STBTT_DEF int stbtt_FindGlyphIndex(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int unicode_codepoint); +// If you're going to perform multiple operations on the same character +// and you want a speed-up, call this function with the character you're +// going to process, then use glyph-based functions instead of the +// codepoint-based functions. +// Returns 0 if the character codepoint is not defined in the font. + + +////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +// +// CHARACTER PROPERTIES +// + +STBTT_DEF float stbtt_ScaleForPixelHeight(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, float pixels); +// computes a scale factor to produce a font whose "height" is 'pixels' tall. +// Height is measured as the distance from the highest ascender to the lowest +// descender; in other words, it's equivalent to calling stbtt_GetFontVMetrics +// and computing: +// scale = pixels / (ascent - descent) +// so if you prefer to measure height by the ascent only, use a similar calculation. + +STBTT_DEF float stbtt_ScaleForMappingEmToPixels(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, float pixels); +// computes a scale factor to produce a font whose EM size is mapped to +// 'pixels' tall. This is probably what traditional APIs compute, but +// I'm not positive. + +STBTT_DEF void stbtt_GetFontVMetrics(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int *ascent, int *descent, int *lineGap); +// ascent is the coordinate above the baseline the font extends; descent +// is the coordinate below the baseline the font extends (i.e. it is typically negative) +// lineGap is the spacing between one row's descent and the next row's ascent... +// so you should advance the vertical position by "*ascent - *descent + *lineGap" +// these are expressed in unscaled coordinates, so you must multiply by +// the scale factor for a given size + +STBTT_DEF int stbtt_GetFontVMetricsOS2(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int *typoAscent, int *typoDescent, int *typoLineGap); +// analogous to GetFontVMetrics, but returns the "typographic" values from the OS/2 +// table (specific to MS/Windows TTF files). +// +// Returns 1 on success (table present), 0 on failure. + +STBTT_DEF void stbtt_GetFontBoundingBox(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int *x0, int *y0, int *x1, int *y1); +// the bounding box around all possible characters + +STBTT_DEF void stbtt_GetCodepointHMetrics(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int codepoint, int *advanceWidth, int *leftSideBearing); +// leftSideBearing is the offset from the current horizontal position to the left edge of the character +// advanceWidth is the offset from the current horizontal position to the next horizontal position +// these are expressed in unscaled coordinates + +STBTT_DEF int stbtt_GetCodepointKernAdvance(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int ch1, int ch2); +// an additional amount to add to the 'advance' value between ch1 and ch2 + +STBTT_DEF int stbtt_GetCodepointBox(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int codepoint, int *x0, int *y0, int *x1, int *y1); +// Gets the bounding box of the visible part of the glyph, in unscaled coordinates + +STBTT_DEF void stbtt_GetGlyphHMetrics(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int glyph_index, int *advanceWidth, int *leftSideBearing); +STBTT_DEF int stbtt_GetGlyphKernAdvance(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int glyph1, int glyph2); +STBTT_DEF int stbtt_GetGlyphBox(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int glyph_index, int *x0, int *y0, int *x1, int *y1); +// as above, but takes one or more glyph indices for greater efficiency + + +////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +// +// GLYPH SHAPES (you probably don't need these, but they have to go before +// the bitmaps for C declaration-order reasons) +// + +#ifndef STBTT_vmove // you can predefine these to use different values (but why?) + enum { + STBTT_vmove=1, + STBTT_vline, + STBTT_vcurve, + STBTT_vcubic + }; +#endif + +#ifndef stbtt_vertex // you can predefine this to use different values + // (we share this with other code at RAD) + #define stbtt_vertex_type short // can't use stbtt_int16 because that's not visible in the header file + typedef struct + { + stbtt_vertex_type x,y,cx,cy,cx1,cy1; + unsigned char type,padding; + } stbtt_vertex; +#endif + +STBTT_DEF int stbtt_IsGlyphEmpty(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int glyph_index); +// returns non-zero if nothing is drawn for this glyph + +STBTT_DEF int stbtt_GetCodepointShape(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int unicode_codepoint, stbtt_vertex **vertices); +STBTT_DEF int stbtt_GetGlyphShape(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int glyph_index, stbtt_vertex **vertices); +// returns # of vertices and fills *vertices with the pointer to them +// these are expressed in "unscaled" coordinates +// +// The shape is a series of contours. Each one starts with +// a STBTT_moveto, then consists of a series of mixed +// STBTT_lineto and STBTT_curveto segments. A lineto +// draws a line from previous endpoint to its x,y; a curveto +// draws a quadratic bezier from previous endpoint to +// its x,y, using cx,cy as the bezier control point. + +STBTT_DEF void stbtt_FreeShape(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, stbtt_vertex *vertices); +// frees the data allocated above + +////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +// +// BITMAP RENDERING +// + +STBTT_DEF void stbtt_FreeBitmap(unsigned char *bitmap, void *userdata); +// frees the bitmap allocated below + +STBTT_DEF unsigned char *stbtt_GetCodepointBitmap(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, float scale_x, float scale_y, int codepoint, int *width, int *height, int *xoff, int *yoff); +// allocates a large-enough single-channel 8bpp bitmap and renders the +// specified character/glyph at the specified scale into it, with +// antialiasing. 0 is no coverage (transparent), 255 is fully covered (opaque). +// *width & *height are filled out with the width & height of the bitmap, +// which is stored left-to-right, top-to-bottom. +// +// xoff/yoff are the offset it pixel space from the glyph origin to the top-left of the bitmap + +STBTT_DEF unsigned char *stbtt_GetCodepointBitmapSubpixel(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, float scale_x, float scale_y, float shift_x, float shift_y, int codepoint, int *width, int *height, int *xoff, int *yoff); +// the same as stbtt_GetCodepoitnBitmap, but you can specify a subpixel +// shift for the character + +STBTT_DEF void stbtt_MakeCodepointBitmap(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, unsigned char *output, int out_w, int out_h, int out_stride, float scale_x, float scale_y, int codepoint); +// the same as stbtt_GetCodepointBitmap, but you pass in storage for the bitmap +// in the form of 'output', with row spacing of 'out_stride' bytes. the bitmap +// is clipped to out_w/out_h bytes. Call stbtt_GetCodepointBitmapBox to get the +// width and height and positioning info for it first. + +STBTT_DEF void stbtt_MakeCodepointBitmapSubpixel(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, unsigned char *output, int out_w, int out_h, int out_stride, float scale_x, float scale_y, float shift_x, float shift_y, int codepoint); +// same as stbtt_MakeCodepointBitmap, but you can specify a subpixel +// shift for the character + +STBTT_DEF void stbtt_MakeCodepointBitmapSubpixelPrefilter(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, unsigned char *output, int out_w, int out_h, int out_stride, float scale_x, float scale_y, float shift_x, float shift_y, int oversample_x, int oversample_y, float *sub_x, float *sub_y, int codepoint); +// same as stbtt_MakeCodepointBitmapSubpixel, but prefiltering +// is performed (see stbtt_PackSetOversampling) + +STBTT_DEF void stbtt_GetCodepointBitmapBox(const stbtt_fontinfo *font, int codepoint, float scale_x, float scale_y, int *ix0, int *iy0, int *ix1, int *iy1); +// get the bbox of the bitmap centered around the glyph origin; so the +// bitmap width is ix1-ix0, height is iy1-iy0, and location to place +// the bitmap top left is (leftSideBearing*scale,iy0). +// (Note that the bitmap uses y-increases-down, but the shape uses +// y-increases-up, so CodepointBitmapBox and CodepointBox are inverted.) + +STBTT_DEF void stbtt_GetCodepointBitmapBoxSubpixel(const stbtt_fontinfo *font, int codepoint, float scale_x, float scale_y, float shift_x, float shift_y, int *ix0, int *iy0, int *ix1, int *iy1); +// same as stbtt_GetCodepointBitmapBox, but you can specify a subpixel +// shift for the character + +// the following functions are equivalent to the above functions, but operate +// on glyph indices instead of Unicode codepoints (for efficiency) +STBTT_DEF unsigned char *stbtt_GetGlyphBitmap(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, float scale_x, float scale_y, int glyph, int *width, int *height, int *xoff, int *yoff); +STBTT_DEF unsigned char *stbtt_GetGlyphBitmapSubpixel(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, float scale_x, float scale_y, float shift_x, float shift_y, int glyph, int *width, int *height, int *xoff, int *yoff); +STBTT_DEF void stbtt_MakeGlyphBitmap(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, unsigned char *output, int out_w, int out_h, int out_stride, float scale_x, float scale_y, int glyph); +STBTT_DEF void stbtt_MakeGlyphBitmapSubpixel(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, unsigned char *output, int out_w, int out_h, int out_stride, float scale_x, float scale_y, float shift_x, float shift_y, int glyph); +STBTT_DEF void stbtt_MakeGlyphBitmapSubpixelPrefilter(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, unsigned char *output, int out_w, int out_h, int out_stride, float scale_x, float scale_y, float shift_x, float shift_y, int oversample_x, int oversample_y, float *sub_x, float *sub_y, int glyph); +STBTT_DEF void stbtt_GetGlyphBitmapBox(const stbtt_fontinfo *font, int glyph, float scale_x, float scale_y, int *ix0, int *iy0, int *ix1, int *iy1); +STBTT_DEF void stbtt_GetGlyphBitmapBoxSubpixel(const stbtt_fontinfo *font, int glyph, float scale_x, float scale_y,float shift_x, float shift_y, int *ix0, int *iy0, int *ix1, int *iy1); + + +// @TODO: don't expose this structure +typedef struct +{ + int w,h,stride; + unsigned char *pixels; +} stbtt__bitmap; + +// rasterize a shape with quadratic beziers into a bitmap +STBTT_DEF void stbtt_Rasterize(stbtt__bitmap *result, // 1-channel bitmap to draw into + float flatness_in_pixels, // allowable error of curve in pixels + stbtt_vertex *vertices, // array of vertices defining shape + int num_verts, // number of vertices in above array + float scale_x, float scale_y, // scale applied to input vertices + float shift_x, float shift_y, // translation applied to input vertices + int x_off, int y_off, // another translation applied to input + int invert, // if non-zero, vertically flip shape + void *userdata); // context for to STBTT_MALLOC + +////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +// +// Signed Distance Function (or Field) rendering + +STBTT_DEF void stbtt_FreeSDF(unsigned char *bitmap, void *userdata); +// frees the SDF bitmap allocated below + +STBTT_DEF unsigned char * stbtt_GetGlyphSDF(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, float scale, int glyph, int padding, unsigned char onedge_value, float pixel_dist_scale, int *width, int *height, int *xoff, int *yoff); +STBTT_DEF unsigned char * stbtt_GetCodepointSDF(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, float scale, int codepoint, int padding, unsigned char onedge_value, float pixel_dist_scale, int *width, int *height, int *xoff, int *yoff); +// These functions compute a discretized SDF field for a single character, suitable for storing +// in a single-channel texture, sampling with bilinear filtering, and testing against +// larger than some threshold to produce scalable fonts. +// info -- the font +// scale -- controls the size of the resulting SDF bitmap, same as it would be creating a regular bitmap +// glyph/codepoint -- the character to generate the SDF for +// padding -- extra "pixels" around the character which are filled with the distance to the character (not 0), +// which allows effects like bit outlines +// onedge_value -- value 0-255 to test the SDF against to reconstruct the character (i.e. the isocontour of the character) +// pixel_dist_scale -- what value the SDF should increase by when moving one SDF "pixel" away from the edge (on the 0..255 scale) +// if positive, > onedge_value is inside; if negative, < onedge_value is inside +// width,height -- output height & width of the SDF bitmap (including padding) +// xoff,yoff -- output origin of the character +// return value -- a 2D array of bytes 0..255, width*height in size +// +// pixel_dist_scale & onedge_value are a scale & bias that allows you to make +// optimal use of the limited 0..255 for your application, trading off precision +// and special effects. SDF values outside the range 0..255 are clamped to 0..255. +// +// Example: +// scale = stbtt_ScaleForPixelHeight(22) +// padding = 5 +// onedge_value = 180 +// pixel_dist_scale = 180/5.0 = 36.0 +// +// This will create an SDF bitmap in which the character is about 22 pixels +// high but the whole bitmap is about 22+5+5=32 pixels high. To produce a filled +// shape, sample the SDF at each pixel and fill the pixel if the SDF value +// is greater than or equal to 180/255. (You'll actually want to antialias, +// which is beyond the scope of this example.) Additionally, you can compute +// offset outlines (e.g. to stroke the character border inside & outside, +// or only outside). For example, to fill outside the character up to 3 SDF +// pixels, you would compare against (180-36.0*3)/255 = 72/255. The above +// choice of variables maps a range from 5 pixels outside the shape to +// 2 pixels inside the shape to 0..255; this is intended primarily for apply +// outside effects only (the interior range is needed to allow proper +// antialiasing of the font at *smaller* sizes) +// +// The function computes the SDF analytically at each SDF pixel, not by e.g. +// building a higher-res bitmap and approximating it. In theory the quality +// should be as high as possible for an SDF of this size & representation, but +// unclear if this is true in practice (perhaps building a higher-res bitmap +// and computing from that can allow drop-out prevention). +// +// The algorithm has not been optimized at all, so expect it to be slow +// if computing lots of characters or very large sizes. + + + +////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +// +// Finding the right font... +// +// You should really just solve this offline, keep your own tables +// of what font is what, and don't try to get it out of the .ttf file. +// That's because getting it out of the .ttf file is really hard, because +// the names in the file can appear in many possible encodings, in many +// possible languages, and e.g. if you need a case-insensitive comparison, +// the details of that depend on the encoding & language in a complex way +// (actually underspecified in truetype, but also gigantic). +// +// But you can use the provided functions in two possible ways: +// stbtt_FindMatchingFont() will use *case-sensitive* comparisons on +// unicode-encoded names to try to find the font you want; +// you can run this before calling stbtt_InitFont() +// +// stbtt_GetFontNameString() lets you get any of the various strings +// from the file yourself and do your own comparisons on them. +// You have to have called stbtt_InitFont() first. + + +STBTT_DEF int stbtt_FindMatchingFont(const unsigned char *fontdata, const char *name, int flags); +// returns the offset (not index) of the font that matches, or -1 if none +// if you use STBTT_MACSTYLE_DONTCARE, use a font name like "Arial Bold". +// if you use any other flag, use a font name like "Arial"; this checks +// the 'macStyle' header field; i don't know if fonts set this consistently +#define STBTT_MACSTYLE_DONTCARE 0 +#define STBTT_MACSTYLE_BOLD 1 +#define STBTT_MACSTYLE_ITALIC 2 +#define STBTT_MACSTYLE_UNDERSCORE 4 +#define STBTT_MACSTYLE_NONE 8 // <= not same as 0, this makes us check the bitfield is 0 + +STBTT_DEF int stbtt_CompareUTF8toUTF16_bigendian(const char *s1, int len1, const char *s2, int len2); +// returns 1/0 whether the first string interpreted as utf8 is identical to +// the second string interpreted as big-endian utf16... useful for strings from next func + +STBTT_DEF const char *stbtt_GetFontNameString(const stbtt_fontinfo *font, int *length, int platformID, int encodingID, int languageID, int nameID); +// returns the string (which may be big-endian double byte, e.g. for unicode) +// and puts the length in bytes in *length. +// +// some of the values for the IDs are below; for more see the truetype spec: +// http://developer.apple.com/textfonts/TTRefMan/RM06/Chap6name.html +// http://www.microsoft.com/typography/otspec/name.htm + +enum { // platformID + STBTT_PLATFORM_ID_UNICODE =0, + STBTT_PLATFORM_ID_MAC =1, + STBTT_PLATFORM_ID_ISO =2, + STBTT_PLATFORM_ID_MICROSOFT =3 +}; + +enum { // encodingID for STBTT_PLATFORM_ID_UNICODE + STBTT_UNICODE_EID_UNICODE_1_0 =0, + STBTT_UNICODE_EID_UNICODE_1_1 =1, + STBTT_UNICODE_EID_ISO_10646 =2, + STBTT_UNICODE_EID_UNICODE_2_0_BMP=3, + STBTT_UNICODE_EID_UNICODE_2_0_FULL=4 +}; + +enum { // encodingID for STBTT_PLATFORM_ID_MICROSOFT + STBTT_MS_EID_SYMBOL =0, + STBTT_MS_EID_UNICODE_BMP =1, + STBTT_MS_EID_SHIFTJIS =2, + STBTT_MS_EID_UNICODE_FULL =10 +}; + +enum { // encodingID for STBTT_PLATFORM_ID_MAC; same as Script Manager codes + STBTT_MAC_EID_ROMAN =0, STBTT_MAC_EID_ARABIC =4, + STBTT_MAC_EID_JAPANESE =1, STBTT_MAC_EID_HEBREW =5, + STBTT_MAC_EID_CHINESE_TRAD =2, STBTT_MAC_EID_GREEK =6, + STBTT_MAC_EID_KOREAN =3, STBTT_MAC_EID_RUSSIAN =7 +}; + +enum { // languageID for STBTT_PLATFORM_ID_MICROSOFT; same as LCID... + // problematic because there are e.g. 16 english LCIDs and 16 arabic LCIDs + STBTT_MS_LANG_ENGLISH =0x0409, STBTT_MS_LANG_ITALIAN =0x0410, + STBTT_MS_LANG_CHINESE =0x0804, STBTT_MS_LANG_JAPANESE =0x0411, + STBTT_MS_LANG_DUTCH =0x0413, STBTT_MS_LANG_KOREAN =0x0412, + STBTT_MS_LANG_FRENCH =0x040c, STBTT_MS_LANG_RUSSIAN =0x0419, + STBTT_MS_LANG_GERMAN =0x0407, STBTT_MS_LANG_SPANISH =0x0409, + STBTT_MS_LANG_HEBREW =0x040d, STBTT_MS_LANG_SWEDISH =0x041D +}; + +enum { // languageID for STBTT_PLATFORM_ID_MAC + STBTT_MAC_LANG_ENGLISH =0 , STBTT_MAC_LANG_JAPANESE =11, + STBTT_MAC_LANG_ARABIC =12, STBTT_MAC_LANG_KOREAN =23, + STBTT_MAC_LANG_DUTCH =4 , STBTT_MAC_LANG_RUSSIAN =32, + STBTT_MAC_LANG_FRENCH =1 , STBTT_MAC_LANG_SPANISH =6 , + STBTT_MAC_LANG_GERMAN =2 , STBTT_MAC_LANG_SWEDISH =5 , + STBTT_MAC_LANG_HEBREW =10, STBTT_MAC_LANG_CHINESE_SIMPLIFIED =33, + STBTT_MAC_LANG_ITALIAN =3 , STBTT_MAC_LANG_CHINESE_TRAD =19 +}; + +#ifdef __cplusplus +} +#endif + +#endif // __STB_INCLUDE_STB_TRUETYPE_H__ + +/////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +/////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +//// +//// IMPLEMENTATION +//// +//// + +#ifdef STB_TRUETYPE_IMPLEMENTATION + +#ifndef STBTT_MAX_OVERSAMPLE +#define STBTT_MAX_OVERSAMPLE 8 +#endif + +#if STBTT_MAX_OVERSAMPLE > 255 +#error "STBTT_MAX_OVERSAMPLE cannot be > 255" +#endif + +typedef int stbtt__test_oversample_pow2[(STBTT_MAX_OVERSAMPLE & (STBTT_MAX_OVERSAMPLE-1)) == 0 ? 1 : -1]; + +#ifndef STBTT_RASTERIZER_VERSION +#define STBTT_RASTERIZER_VERSION 2 +#endif + +#ifdef _MSC_VER +#define STBTT__NOTUSED(v) (void)(v) +#else +#define STBTT__NOTUSED(v) (void)sizeof(v) +#endif + +////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +// +// stbtt__buf helpers to parse data from file +// + +static stbtt_uint8 stbtt__buf_get8(stbtt__buf *b) +{ + if (b->cursor >= b->size) + return 0; + return b->data[b->cursor++]; +} + +static stbtt_uint8 stbtt__buf_peek8(stbtt__buf *b) +{ + if (b->cursor >= b->size) + return 0; + return b->data[b->cursor]; +} + +static void stbtt__buf_seek(stbtt__buf *b, int o) +{ + STBTT_assert(!(o > b->size || o < 0)); + b->cursor = (o > b->size || o < 0) ? b->size : o; +} + +static void stbtt__buf_skip(stbtt__buf *b, int o) +{ + stbtt__buf_seek(b, b->cursor + o); +} + +static stbtt_uint32 stbtt__buf_get(stbtt__buf *b, int n) +{ + stbtt_uint32 v = 0; + int i; + STBTT_assert(n >= 1 && n <= 4); + for (i = 0; i < n; i++) + v = (v << 8) | stbtt__buf_get8(b); + return v; +} + +static stbtt__buf stbtt__new_buf(const void *p, size_t size) +{ + stbtt__buf r; + STBTT_assert(size < 0x40000000); + r.data = (stbtt_uint8*) p; + r.size = (int) size; + r.cursor = 0; + return r; +} + +#define stbtt__buf_get16(b) stbtt__buf_get((b), 2) +#define stbtt__buf_get32(b) stbtt__buf_get((b), 4) + +static stbtt__buf stbtt__buf_range(const stbtt__buf *b, int o, int s) +{ + stbtt__buf r = stbtt__new_buf(NULL, 0); + if (o < 0 || s < 0 || o > b->size || s > b->size - o) return r; + r.data = b->data + o; + r.size = s; + return r; +} + +static stbtt__buf stbtt__cff_get_index(stbtt__buf *b) +{ + int count, start, offsize; + start = b->cursor; + count = stbtt__buf_get16(b); + if (count) { + offsize = stbtt__buf_get8(b); + STBTT_assert(offsize >= 1 && offsize <= 4); + stbtt__buf_skip(b, offsize * count); + stbtt__buf_skip(b, stbtt__buf_get(b, offsize) - 1); + } + return stbtt__buf_range(b, start, b->cursor - start); +} + +static stbtt_uint32 stbtt__cff_int(stbtt__buf *b) +{ + int b0 = stbtt__buf_get8(b); + if (b0 >= 32 && b0 <= 246) return b0 - 139; + else if (b0 >= 247 && b0 <= 250) return (b0 - 247)*256 + stbtt__buf_get8(b) + 108; + else if (b0 >= 251 && b0 <= 254) return -(b0 - 251)*256 - stbtt__buf_get8(b) - 108; + else if (b0 == 28) return stbtt__buf_get16(b); + else if (b0 == 29) return stbtt__buf_get32(b); + STBTT_assert(0); + return 0; +} + +static void stbtt__cff_skip_operand(stbtt__buf *b) { + int v, b0 = stbtt__buf_peek8(b); + STBTT_assert(b0 >= 28); + if (b0 == 30) { + stbtt__buf_skip(b, 1); + while (b->cursor < b->size) { + v = stbtt__buf_get8(b); + if ((v & 0xF) == 0xF || (v >> 4) == 0xF) + break; + } + } else { + stbtt__cff_int(b); + } +} + +static stbtt__buf stbtt__dict_get(stbtt__buf *b, int key) +{ + stbtt__buf_seek(b, 0); + while (b->cursor < b->size) { + int start = b->cursor, end, op; + while (stbtt__buf_peek8(b) >= 28) + stbtt__cff_skip_operand(b); + end = b->cursor; + op = stbtt__buf_get8(b); + if (op == 12) op = stbtt__buf_get8(b) | 0x100; + if (op == key) return stbtt__buf_range(b, start, end-start); + } + return stbtt__buf_range(b, 0, 0); +} + +static void stbtt__dict_get_ints(stbtt__buf *b, int key, int outcount, stbtt_uint32 *out) +{ + int i; + stbtt__buf operands = stbtt__dict_get(b, key); + for (i = 0; i < outcount && operands.cursor < operands.size; i++) + out[i] = stbtt__cff_int(&operands); +} + +static int stbtt__cff_index_count(stbtt__buf *b) +{ + stbtt__buf_seek(b, 0); + return stbtt__buf_get16(b); +} + +static stbtt__buf stbtt__cff_index_get(stbtt__buf b, int i) +{ + int count, offsize, start, end; + stbtt__buf_seek(&b, 0); + count = stbtt__buf_get16(&b); + offsize = stbtt__buf_get8(&b); + STBTT_assert(i >= 0 && i < count); + STBTT_assert(offsize >= 1 && offsize <= 4); + stbtt__buf_skip(&b, i*offsize); + start = stbtt__buf_get(&b, offsize); + end = stbtt__buf_get(&b, offsize); + return stbtt__buf_range(&b, 2+(count+1)*offsize+start, end - start); +} + +////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +// +// accessors to parse data from file +// + +// on platforms that don't allow misaligned reads, if we want to allow +// truetype fonts that aren't padded to alignment, define ALLOW_UNALIGNED_TRUETYPE + +#define ttBYTE(p) (* (stbtt_uint8 *) (p)) +#define ttCHAR(p) (* (stbtt_int8 *) (p)) +#define ttFixed(p) ttLONG(p) + +static stbtt_uint16 ttUSHORT(stbtt_uint8 *p) { return p[0]*256 + p[1]; } +static stbtt_int16 ttSHORT(stbtt_uint8 *p) { return p[0]*256 + p[1]; } +static stbtt_uint32 ttULONG(stbtt_uint8 *p) { return (p[0]<<24) + (p[1]<<16) + (p[2]<<8) + p[3]; } +static stbtt_int32 ttLONG(stbtt_uint8 *p) { return (p[0]<<24) + (p[1]<<16) + (p[2]<<8) + p[3]; } + +#define stbtt_tag4(p,c0,c1,c2,c3) ((p)[0] == (c0) && (p)[1] == (c1) && (p)[2] == (c2) && (p)[3] == (c3)) +#define stbtt_tag(p,str) stbtt_tag4(p,str[0],str[1],str[2],str[3]) + +static int stbtt__isfont(stbtt_uint8 *font) +{ + // check the version number + if (stbtt_tag4(font, '1',0,0,0)) return 1; // TrueType 1 + if (stbtt_tag(font, "typ1")) return 1; // TrueType with type 1 font -- we don't support this! + if (stbtt_tag(font, "OTTO")) return 1; // OpenType with CFF + if (stbtt_tag4(font, 0,1,0,0)) return 1; // OpenType 1.0 + if (stbtt_tag(font, "true")) return 1; // Apple specification for TrueType fonts + return 0; +} + +// @OPTIMIZE: binary search +static stbtt_uint32 stbtt__find_table(stbtt_uint8 *data, stbtt_uint32 fontstart, const char *tag) +{ + stbtt_int32 num_tables = ttUSHORT(data+fontstart+4); + stbtt_uint32 tabledir = fontstart + 12; + stbtt_int32 i; + for (i=0; i < num_tables; ++i) { + stbtt_uint32 loc = tabledir + 16*i; + if (stbtt_tag(data+loc+0, tag)) + return ttULONG(data+loc+8); + } + return 0; +} + +static int stbtt_GetFontOffsetForIndex_internal(unsigned char *font_collection, int index) +{ + // if it's just a font, there's only one valid index + if (stbtt__isfont(font_collection)) + return index == 0 ? 0 : -1; + + // check if it's a TTC + if (stbtt_tag(font_collection, "ttcf")) { + // version 1? + if (ttULONG(font_collection+4) == 0x00010000 || ttULONG(font_collection+4) == 0x00020000) { + stbtt_int32 n = ttLONG(font_collection+8); + if (index >= n) + return -1; + return ttULONG(font_collection+12+index*4); + } + } + return -1; +} + +static int stbtt_GetNumberOfFonts_internal(unsigned char *font_collection) +{ + // if it's just a font, there's only one valid font + if (stbtt__isfont(font_collection)) + return 1; + + // check if it's a TTC + if (stbtt_tag(font_collection, "ttcf")) { + // version 1? + if (ttULONG(font_collection+4) == 0x00010000 || ttULONG(font_collection+4) == 0x00020000) { + return ttLONG(font_collection+8); + } + } + return 0; +} + +static stbtt__buf stbtt__get_subrs(stbtt__buf cff, stbtt__buf fontdict) +{ + stbtt_uint32 subrsoff = 0, private_loc[2] = { 0, 0 }; + stbtt__buf pdict; + stbtt__dict_get_ints(&fontdict, 18, 2, private_loc); + if (!private_loc[1] || !private_loc[0]) return stbtt__new_buf(NULL, 0); + pdict = stbtt__buf_range(&cff, private_loc[1], private_loc[0]); + stbtt__dict_get_ints(&pdict, 19, 1, &subrsoff); + if (!subrsoff) return stbtt__new_buf(NULL, 0); + stbtt__buf_seek(&cff, private_loc[1]+subrsoff); + return stbtt__cff_get_index(&cff); +} + +static int stbtt_InitFont_internal(stbtt_fontinfo *info, unsigned char *data, int fontstart) +{ + stbtt_uint32 cmap, t; + stbtt_int32 i,numTables; + + info->data = data; + info->fontstart = fontstart; + info->cff = stbtt__new_buf(NULL, 0); + + cmap = stbtt__find_table(data, fontstart, "cmap"); // required + info->loca = stbtt__find_table(data, fontstart, "loca"); // required + info->head = stbtt__find_table(data, fontstart, "head"); // required + info->glyf = stbtt__find_table(data, fontstart, "glyf"); // required + info->hhea = stbtt__find_table(data, fontstart, "hhea"); // required + info->hmtx = stbtt__find_table(data, fontstart, "hmtx"); // required + info->kern = stbtt__find_table(data, fontstart, "kern"); // not required + info->gpos = stbtt__find_table(data, fontstart, "GPOS"); // not required + + if (!cmap || !info->head || !info->hhea || !info->hmtx) + return 0; + if (info->glyf) { + // required for truetype + if (!info->loca) return 0; + } else { + // initialization for CFF / Type2 fonts (OTF) + stbtt__buf b, topdict, topdictidx; + stbtt_uint32 cstype = 2, charstrings = 0, fdarrayoff = 0, fdselectoff = 0; + stbtt_uint32 cff; + + cff = stbtt__find_table(data, fontstart, "CFF "); + if (!cff) return 0; + + info->fontdicts = stbtt__new_buf(NULL, 0); + info->fdselect = stbtt__new_buf(NULL, 0); + + // @TODO this should use size from table (not 512MB) + info->cff = stbtt__new_buf(data+cff, 512*1024*1024); + b = info->cff; + + // read the header + stbtt__buf_skip(&b, 2); + stbtt__buf_seek(&b, stbtt__buf_get8(&b)); // hdrsize + + // @TODO the name INDEX could list multiple fonts, + // but we just use the first one. + stbtt__cff_get_index(&b); // name INDEX + topdictidx = stbtt__cff_get_index(&b); + topdict = stbtt__cff_index_get(topdictidx, 0); + stbtt__cff_get_index(&b); // string INDEX + info->gsubrs = stbtt__cff_get_index(&b); + + stbtt__dict_get_ints(&topdict, 17, 1, &charstrings); + stbtt__dict_get_ints(&topdict, 0x100 | 6, 1, &cstype); + stbtt__dict_get_ints(&topdict, 0x100 | 36, 1, &fdarrayoff); + stbtt__dict_get_ints(&topdict, 0x100 | 37, 1, &fdselectoff); + info->subrs = stbtt__get_subrs(b, topdict); + + // we only support Type 2 charstrings + if (cstype != 2) return 0; + if (charstrings == 0) return 0; + + if (fdarrayoff) { + // looks like a CID font + if (!fdselectoff) return 0; + stbtt__buf_seek(&b, fdarrayoff); + info->fontdicts = stbtt__cff_get_index(&b); + info->fdselect = stbtt__buf_range(&b, fdselectoff, b.size-fdselectoff); + } + + stbtt__buf_seek(&b, charstrings); + info->charstrings = stbtt__cff_get_index(&b); + } + + t = stbtt__find_table(data, fontstart, "maxp"); + if (t) + info->numGlyphs = ttUSHORT(data+t+4); + else + info->numGlyphs = 0xffff; + + // find a cmap encoding table we understand *now* to avoid searching + // later. (todo: could make this installable) + // the same regardless of glyph. + numTables = ttUSHORT(data + cmap + 2); + info->index_map = 0; + for (i=0; i < numTables; ++i) { + stbtt_uint32 encoding_record = cmap + 4 + 8 * i; + // find an encoding we understand: + switch(ttUSHORT(data+encoding_record)) { + case STBTT_PLATFORM_ID_MICROSOFT: + switch (ttUSHORT(data+encoding_record+2)) { + case STBTT_MS_EID_UNICODE_BMP: + case STBTT_MS_EID_UNICODE_FULL: + // MS/Unicode + info->index_map = cmap + ttULONG(data+encoding_record+4); + break; + } + break; + case STBTT_PLATFORM_ID_UNICODE: + // Mac/iOS has these + // all the encodingIDs are unicode, so we don't bother to check it + info->index_map = cmap + ttULONG(data+encoding_record+4); + break; + } + } + if (info->index_map == 0) + return 0; + + info->indexToLocFormat = ttUSHORT(data+info->head + 50); + return 1; +} + +STBTT_DEF int stbtt_FindGlyphIndex(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int unicode_codepoint) +{ + stbtt_uint8 *data = info->data; + stbtt_uint32 index_map = info->index_map; + + stbtt_uint16 format = ttUSHORT(data + index_map + 0); + if (format == 0) { // apple byte encoding + stbtt_int32 bytes = ttUSHORT(data + index_map + 2); + if (unicode_codepoint < bytes-6) + return ttBYTE(data + index_map + 6 + unicode_codepoint); + return 0; + } else if (format == 6) { + stbtt_uint32 first = ttUSHORT(data + index_map + 6); + stbtt_uint32 count = ttUSHORT(data + index_map + 8); + if ((stbtt_uint32) unicode_codepoint >= first && (stbtt_uint32) unicode_codepoint < first+count) + return ttUSHORT(data + index_map + 10 + (unicode_codepoint - first)*2); + return 0; + } else if (format == 2) { + STBTT_assert(0); // @TODO: high-byte mapping for japanese/chinese/korean + return 0; + } else if (format == 4) { // standard mapping for windows fonts: binary search collection of ranges + stbtt_uint16 segcount = ttUSHORT(data+index_map+6) >> 1; + stbtt_uint16 searchRange = ttUSHORT(data+index_map+8) >> 1; + stbtt_uint16 entrySelector = ttUSHORT(data+index_map+10); + stbtt_uint16 rangeShift = ttUSHORT(data+index_map+12) >> 1; + + // do a binary search of the segments + stbtt_uint32 endCount = index_map + 14; + stbtt_uint32 search = endCount; + + if (unicode_codepoint > 0xffff) + return 0; + + // they lie from endCount .. endCount + segCount + // but searchRange is the nearest power of two, so... + if (unicode_codepoint >= ttUSHORT(data + search + rangeShift*2)) + search += rangeShift*2; + + // now decrement to bias correctly to find smallest + search -= 2; + while (entrySelector) { + stbtt_uint16 end; + searchRange >>= 1; + end = ttUSHORT(data + search + searchRange*2); + if (unicode_codepoint > end) + search += searchRange*2; + --entrySelector; + } + search += 2; + + { + stbtt_uint16 offset, start; + stbtt_uint16 item = (stbtt_uint16) ((search - endCount) >> 1); + + STBTT_assert(unicode_codepoint <= ttUSHORT(data + endCount + 2*item)); + start = ttUSHORT(data + index_map + 14 + segcount*2 + 2 + 2*item); + if (unicode_codepoint < start) + return 0; + + offset = ttUSHORT(data + index_map + 14 + segcount*6 + 2 + 2*item); + if (offset == 0) + return (stbtt_uint16) (unicode_codepoint + ttSHORT(data + index_map + 14 + segcount*4 + 2 + 2*item)); + + return ttUSHORT(data + offset + (unicode_codepoint-start)*2 + index_map + 14 + segcount*6 + 2 + 2*item); + } + } else if (format == 12 || format == 13) { + stbtt_uint32 ngroups = ttULONG(data+index_map+12); + stbtt_int32 low,high; + low = 0; high = (stbtt_int32)ngroups; + // Binary search the right group. + while (low < high) { + stbtt_int32 mid = low + ((high-low) >> 1); // rounds down, so low <= mid < high + stbtt_uint32 start_char = ttULONG(data+index_map+16+mid*12); + stbtt_uint32 end_char = ttULONG(data+index_map+16+mid*12+4); + if ((stbtt_uint32) unicode_codepoint < start_char) + high = mid; + else if ((stbtt_uint32) unicode_codepoint > end_char) + low = mid+1; + else { + stbtt_uint32 start_glyph = ttULONG(data+index_map+16+mid*12+8); + if (format == 12) + return start_glyph + unicode_codepoint-start_char; + else // format == 13 + return start_glyph; + } + } + return 0; // not found + } + // @TODO + STBTT_assert(0); + return 0; +} + +STBTT_DEF int stbtt_GetCodepointShape(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int unicode_codepoint, stbtt_vertex **vertices) +{ + return stbtt_GetGlyphShape(info, stbtt_FindGlyphIndex(info, unicode_codepoint), vertices); +} + +static void stbtt_setvertex(stbtt_vertex *v, stbtt_uint8 type, stbtt_int32 x, stbtt_int32 y, stbtt_int32 cx, stbtt_int32 cy) +{ + v->type = type; + v->x = (stbtt_int16) x; + v->y = (stbtt_int16) y; + v->cx = (stbtt_int16) cx; + v->cy = (stbtt_int16) cy; +} + +static int stbtt__GetGlyfOffset(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int glyph_index) +{ + int g1,g2; + + STBTT_assert(!info->cff.size); + + if (glyph_index >= info->numGlyphs) return -1; // glyph index out of range + if (info->indexToLocFormat >= 2) return -1; // unknown index->glyph map format + + if (info->indexToLocFormat == 0) { + g1 = info->glyf + ttUSHORT(info->data + info->loca + glyph_index * 2) * 2; + g2 = info->glyf + ttUSHORT(info->data + info->loca + glyph_index * 2 + 2) * 2; + } else { + g1 = info->glyf + ttULONG (info->data + info->loca + glyph_index * 4); + g2 = info->glyf + ttULONG (info->data + info->loca + glyph_index * 4 + 4); + } + + return g1==g2 ? -1 : g1; // if length is 0, return -1 +} + +static int stbtt__GetGlyphInfoT2(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int glyph_index, int *x0, int *y0, int *x1, int *y1); + +STBTT_DEF int stbtt_GetGlyphBox(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int glyph_index, int *x0, int *y0, int *x1, int *y1) +{ + if (info->cff.size) { + stbtt__GetGlyphInfoT2(info, glyph_index, x0, y0, x1, y1); + } else { + int g = stbtt__GetGlyfOffset(info, glyph_index); + if (g < 0) return 0; + + if (x0) *x0 = ttSHORT(info->data + g + 2); + if (y0) *y0 = ttSHORT(info->data + g + 4); + if (x1) *x1 = ttSHORT(info->data + g + 6); + if (y1) *y1 = ttSHORT(info->data + g + 8); + } + return 1; +} + +STBTT_DEF int stbtt_GetCodepointBox(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int codepoint, int *x0, int *y0, int *x1, int *y1) +{ + return stbtt_GetGlyphBox(info, stbtt_FindGlyphIndex(info,codepoint), x0,y0,x1,y1); +} + +STBTT_DEF int stbtt_IsGlyphEmpty(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int glyph_index) +{ + stbtt_int16 numberOfContours; + int g; + if (info->cff.size) + return stbtt__GetGlyphInfoT2(info, glyph_index, NULL, NULL, NULL, NULL) == 0; + g = stbtt__GetGlyfOffset(info, glyph_index); + if (g < 0) return 1; + numberOfContours = ttSHORT(info->data + g); + return numberOfContours == 0; +} + +static int stbtt__close_shape(stbtt_vertex *vertices, int num_vertices, int was_off, int start_off, + stbtt_int32 sx, stbtt_int32 sy, stbtt_int32 scx, stbtt_int32 scy, stbtt_int32 cx, stbtt_int32 cy) +{ + if (start_off) { + if (was_off) + stbtt_setvertex(&vertices[num_vertices++], STBTT_vcurve, (cx+scx)>>1, (cy+scy)>>1, cx,cy); + stbtt_setvertex(&vertices[num_vertices++], STBTT_vcurve, sx,sy,scx,scy); + } else { + if (was_off) + stbtt_setvertex(&vertices[num_vertices++], STBTT_vcurve,sx,sy,cx,cy); + else + stbtt_setvertex(&vertices[num_vertices++], STBTT_vline,sx,sy,0,0); + } + return num_vertices; +} + +static int stbtt__GetGlyphShapeTT(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int glyph_index, stbtt_vertex **pvertices) +{ + stbtt_int16 numberOfContours; + stbtt_uint8 *endPtsOfContours; + stbtt_uint8 *data = info->data; + stbtt_vertex *vertices=0; + int num_vertices=0; + int g = stbtt__GetGlyfOffset(info, glyph_index); + + *pvertices = NULL; + + if (g < 0) return 0; + + numberOfContours = ttSHORT(data + g); + + if (numberOfContours > 0) { + stbtt_uint8 flags=0,flagcount; + stbtt_int32 ins, i,j=0,m,n, next_move, was_off=0, off, start_off=0; + stbtt_int32 x,y,cx,cy,sx,sy, scx,scy; + stbtt_uint8 *points; + endPtsOfContours = (data + g + 10); + ins = ttUSHORT(data + g + 10 + numberOfContours * 2); + points = data + g + 10 + numberOfContours * 2 + 2 + ins; + + n = 1+ttUSHORT(endPtsOfContours + numberOfContours*2-2); + + m = n + 2*numberOfContours; // a loose bound on how many vertices we might need + vertices = (stbtt_vertex *) STBTT_malloc(m * sizeof(vertices[0]), info->userdata); + if (vertices == 0) + return 0; + + next_move = 0; + flagcount=0; + + // in first pass, we load uninterpreted data into the allocated array + // above, shifted to the end of the array so we won't overwrite it when + // we create our final data starting from the front + + off = m - n; // starting offset for uninterpreted data, regardless of how m ends up being calculated + + // first load flags + + for (i=0; i < n; ++i) { + if (flagcount == 0) { + flags = *points++; + if (flags & 8) + flagcount = *points++; + } else + --flagcount; + vertices[off+i].type = flags; + } + + // now load x coordinates + x=0; + for (i=0; i < n; ++i) { + flags = vertices[off+i].type; + if (flags & 2) { + stbtt_int16 dx = *points++; + x += (flags & 16) ? dx : -dx; // ??? + } else { + if (!(flags & 16)) { + x = x + (stbtt_int16) (points[0]*256 + points[1]); + points += 2; + } + } + vertices[off+i].x = (stbtt_int16) x; + } + + // now load y coordinates + y=0; + for (i=0; i < n; ++i) { + flags = vertices[off+i].type; + if (flags & 4) { + stbtt_int16 dy = *points++; + y += (flags & 32) ? dy : -dy; // ??? + } else { + if (!(flags & 32)) { + y = y + (stbtt_int16) (points[0]*256 + points[1]); + points += 2; + } + } + vertices[off+i].y = (stbtt_int16) y; + } + + // now convert them to our format + num_vertices=0; + sx = sy = cx = cy = scx = scy = 0; + for (i=0; i < n; ++i) { + flags = vertices[off+i].type; + x = (stbtt_int16) vertices[off+i].x; + y = (stbtt_int16) vertices[off+i].y; + + if (next_move == i) { + if (i != 0) + num_vertices = stbtt__close_shape(vertices, num_vertices, was_off, start_off, sx,sy,scx,scy,cx,cy); + + // now start the new one + start_off = !(flags & 1); + if (start_off) { + // if we start off with an off-curve point, then when we need to find a point on the curve + // where we can start, and we need to save some state for when we wraparound. + scx = x; + scy = y; + if (!(vertices[off+i+1].type & 1)) { + // next point is also a curve point, so interpolate an on-point curve + sx = (x + (stbtt_int32) vertices[off+i+1].x) >> 1; + sy = (y + (stbtt_int32) vertices[off+i+1].y) >> 1; + } else { + // otherwise just use the next point as our start point + sx = (stbtt_int32) vertices[off+i+1].x; + sy = (stbtt_int32) vertices[off+i+1].y; + ++i; // we're using point i+1 as the starting point, so skip it + } + } else { + sx = x; + sy = y; + } + stbtt_setvertex(&vertices[num_vertices++], STBTT_vmove,sx,sy,0,0); + was_off = 0; + next_move = 1 + ttUSHORT(endPtsOfContours+j*2); + ++j; + } else { + if (!(flags & 1)) { // if it's a curve + if (was_off) // two off-curve control points in a row means interpolate an on-curve midpoint + stbtt_setvertex(&vertices[num_vertices++], STBTT_vcurve, (cx+x)>>1, (cy+y)>>1, cx, cy); + cx = x; + cy = y; + was_off = 1; + } else { + if (was_off) + stbtt_setvertex(&vertices[num_vertices++], STBTT_vcurve, x,y, cx, cy); + else + stbtt_setvertex(&vertices[num_vertices++], STBTT_vline, x,y,0,0); + was_off = 0; + } + } + } + num_vertices = stbtt__close_shape(vertices, num_vertices, was_off, start_off, sx,sy,scx,scy,cx,cy); + } else if (numberOfContours == -1) { + // Compound shapes. + int more = 1; + stbtt_uint8 *comp = data + g + 10; + num_vertices = 0; + vertices = 0; + while (more) { + stbtt_uint16 flags, gidx; + int comp_num_verts = 0, i; + stbtt_vertex *comp_verts = 0, *tmp = 0; + float mtx[6] = {1,0,0,1,0,0}, m, n; + + flags = ttSHORT(comp); comp+=2; + gidx = ttSHORT(comp); comp+=2; + + if (flags & 2) { // XY values + if (flags & 1) { // shorts + mtx[4] = ttSHORT(comp); comp+=2; + mtx[5] = ttSHORT(comp); comp+=2; + } else { + mtx[4] = ttCHAR(comp); comp+=1; + mtx[5] = ttCHAR(comp); comp+=1; + } + } + else { + // @TODO handle matching point + STBTT_assert(0); + } + if (flags & (1<<3)) { // WE_HAVE_A_SCALE + mtx[0] = mtx[3] = ttSHORT(comp)/16384.0f; comp+=2; + mtx[1] = mtx[2] = 0; + } else if (flags & (1<<6)) { // WE_HAVE_AN_X_AND_YSCALE + mtx[0] = ttSHORT(comp)/16384.0f; comp+=2; + mtx[1] = mtx[2] = 0; + mtx[3] = ttSHORT(comp)/16384.0f; comp+=2; + } else if (flags & (1<<7)) { // WE_HAVE_A_TWO_BY_TWO + mtx[0] = ttSHORT(comp)/16384.0f; comp+=2; + mtx[1] = ttSHORT(comp)/16384.0f; comp+=2; + mtx[2] = ttSHORT(comp)/16384.0f; comp+=2; + mtx[3] = ttSHORT(comp)/16384.0f; comp+=2; + } + + // Find transformation scales. + m = (float) STBTT_sqrt(mtx[0]*mtx[0] + mtx[1]*mtx[1]); + n = (float) STBTT_sqrt(mtx[2]*mtx[2] + mtx[3]*mtx[3]); + + // Get indexed glyph. + comp_num_verts = stbtt_GetGlyphShape(info, gidx, &comp_verts); + if (comp_num_verts > 0) { + // Transform vertices. + for (i = 0; i < comp_num_verts; ++i) { + stbtt_vertex* v = &comp_verts[i]; + stbtt_vertex_type x,y; + x=v->x; y=v->y; + v->x = (stbtt_vertex_type)(m * (mtx[0]*x + mtx[2]*y + mtx[4])); + v->y = (stbtt_vertex_type)(n * (mtx[1]*x + mtx[3]*y + mtx[5])); + x=v->cx; y=v->cy; + v->cx = (stbtt_vertex_type)(m * (mtx[0]*x + mtx[2]*y + mtx[4])); + v->cy = (stbtt_vertex_type)(n * (mtx[1]*x + mtx[3]*y + mtx[5])); + } + // Append vertices. + tmp = (stbtt_vertex*)STBTT_malloc((num_vertices+comp_num_verts)*sizeof(stbtt_vertex), info->userdata); + if (!tmp) { + if (vertices) STBTT_free(vertices, info->userdata); + if (comp_verts) STBTT_free(comp_verts, info->userdata); + return 0; + } + if (num_vertices > 0) STBTT_memcpy(tmp, vertices, num_vertices*sizeof(stbtt_vertex)); //-V595 + STBTT_memcpy(tmp+num_vertices, comp_verts, comp_num_verts*sizeof(stbtt_vertex)); + if (vertices) STBTT_free(vertices, info->userdata); + vertices = tmp; + STBTT_free(comp_verts, info->userdata); + num_vertices += comp_num_verts; + } + // More components ? + more = flags & (1<<5); + } + } else if (numberOfContours < 0) { + // @TODO other compound variations? + STBTT_assert(0); + } else { + // numberOfCounters == 0, do nothing + } + + *pvertices = vertices; + return num_vertices; +} + +typedef struct +{ + int bounds; + int started; + float first_x, first_y; + float x, y; + stbtt_int32 min_x, max_x, min_y, max_y; + + stbtt_vertex *pvertices; + int num_vertices; +} stbtt__csctx; + +#define STBTT__CSCTX_INIT(bounds) {bounds,0, 0,0, 0,0, 0,0,0,0, NULL, 0} + +static void stbtt__track_vertex(stbtt__csctx *c, stbtt_int32 x, stbtt_int32 y) +{ + if (x > c->max_x || !c->started) c->max_x = x; + if (y > c->max_y || !c->started) c->max_y = y; + if (x < c->min_x || !c->started) c->min_x = x; + if (y < c->min_y || !c->started) c->min_y = y; + c->started = 1; +} + +static void stbtt__csctx_v(stbtt__csctx *c, stbtt_uint8 type, stbtt_int32 x, stbtt_int32 y, stbtt_int32 cx, stbtt_int32 cy, stbtt_int32 cx1, stbtt_int32 cy1) +{ + if (c->bounds) { + stbtt__track_vertex(c, x, y); + if (type == STBTT_vcubic) { + stbtt__track_vertex(c, cx, cy); + stbtt__track_vertex(c, cx1, cy1); + } + } else { + stbtt_setvertex(&c->pvertices[c->num_vertices], type, x, y, cx, cy); + c->pvertices[c->num_vertices].cx1 = (stbtt_int16) cx1; + c->pvertices[c->num_vertices].cy1 = (stbtt_int16) cy1; + } + c->num_vertices++; +} + +static void stbtt__csctx_close_shape(stbtt__csctx *ctx) +{ + if (ctx->first_x != ctx->x || ctx->first_y != ctx->y) + stbtt__csctx_v(ctx, STBTT_vline, (int)ctx->first_x, (int)ctx->first_y, 0, 0, 0, 0); +} + +static void stbtt__csctx_rmove_to(stbtt__csctx *ctx, float dx, float dy) +{ + stbtt__csctx_close_shape(ctx); + ctx->first_x = ctx->x = ctx->x + dx; + ctx->first_y = ctx->y = ctx->y + dy; + stbtt__csctx_v(ctx, STBTT_vmove, (int)ctx->x, (int)ctx->y, 0, 0, 0, 0); +} + +static void stbtt__csctx_rline_to(stbtt__csctx *ctx, float dx, float dy) +{ + ctx->x += dx; + ctx->y += dy; + stbtt__csctx_v(ctx, STBTT_vline, (int)ctx->x, (int)ctx->y, 0, 0, 0, 0); +} + +static void stbtt__csctx_rccurve_to(stbtt__csctx *ctx, float dx1, float dy1, float dx2, float dy2, float dx3, float dy3) +{ + float cx1 = ctx->x + dx1; + float cy1 = ctx->y + dy1; + float cx2 = cx1 + dx2; + float cy2 = cy1 + dy2; + ctx->x = cx2 + dx3; + ctx->y = cy2 + dy3; + stbtt__csctx_v(ctx, STBTT_vcubic, (int)ctx->x, (int)ctx->y, (int)cx1, (int)cy1, (int)cx2, (int)cy2); +} + +static stbtt__buf stbtt__get_subr(stbtt__buf idx, int n) +{ + int count = stbtt__cff_index_count(&idx); + int bias = 107; + if (count >= 33900) + bias = 32768; + else if (count >= 1240) + bias = 1131; + n += bias; + if (n < 0 || n >= count) + return stbtt__new_buf(NULL, 0); + return stbtt__cff_index_get(idx, n); +} + +static stbtt__buf stbtt__cid_get_glyph_subrs(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int glyph_index) +{ + stbtt__buf fdselect = info->fdselect; + int nranges, start, end, v, fmt, fdselector = -1, i; + + stbtt__buf_seek(&fdselect, 0); + fmt = stbtt__buf_get8(&fdselect); + if (fmt == 0) { + // untested + stbtt__buf_skip(&fdselect, glyph_index); + fdselector = stbtt__buf_get8(&fdselect); + } else if (fmt == 3) { + nranges = stbtt__buf_get16(&fdselect); + start = stbtt__buf_get16(&fdselect); + for (i = 0; i < nranges; i++) { + v = stbtt__buf_get8(&fdselect); + end = stbtt__buf_get16(&fdselect); + if (glyph_index >= start && glyph_index < end) { + fdselector = v; + break; + } + start = end; + } + } + if (fdselector == -1) stbtt__new_buf(NULL, 0); + return stbtt__get_subrs(info->cff, stbtt__cff_index_get(info->fontdicts, fdselector)); +} + +static int stbtt__run_charstring(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int glyph_index, stbtt__csctx *c) +{ + int in_header = 1, maskbits = 0, subr_stack_height = 0, sp = 0, v, i, b0; + int has_subrs = 0, clear_stack; + float s[48]; + stbtt__buf subr_stack[10], subrs = info->subrs, b; + float f; + +#define STBTT__CSERR(s) (0) + + // this currently ignores the initial width value, which isn't needed if we have hmtx + b = stbtt__cff_index_get(info->charstrings, glyph_index); + while (b.cursor < b.size) { + i = 0; + clear_stack = 1; + b0 = stbtt__buf_get8(&b); + switch (b0) { + // @TODO implement hinting + case 0x13: // hintmask + case 0x14: // cntrmask + if (in_header) + maskbits += (sp / 2); // implicit "vstem" + in_header = 0; + stbtt__buf_skip(&b, (maskbits + 7) / 8); + break; + + case 0x01: // hstem + case 0x03: // vstem + case 0x12: // hstemhm + case 0x17: // vstemhm + maskbits += (sp / 2); + break; + + case 0x15: // rmoveto + in_header = 0; + if (sp < 2) return STBTT__CSERR("rmoveto stack"); + stbtt__csctx_rmove_to(c, s[sp-2], s[sp-1]); + break; + case 0x04: // vmoveto + in_header = 0; + if (sp < 1) return STBTT__CSERR("vmoveto stack"); + stbtt__csctx_rmove_to(c, 0, s[sp-1]); + break; + case 0x16: // hmoveto + in_header = 0; + if (sp < 1) return STBTT__CSERR("hmoveto stack"); + stbtt__csctx_rmove_to(c, s[sp-1], 0); + break; + + case 0x05: // rlineto + if (sp < 2) return STBTT__CSERR("rlineto stack"); + for (; i + 1 < sp; i += 2) + stbtt__csctx_rline_to(c, s[i], s[i+1]); + break; + + // hlineto/vlineto and vhcurveto/hvcurveto alternate horizontal and vertical + // starting from a different place. + + case 0x07: // vlineto + if (sp < 1) return STBTT__CSERR("vlineto stack"); + goto vlineto; + case 0x06: // hlineto + if (sp < 1) return STBTT__CSERR("hlineto stack"); + for (;;) { + if (i >= sp) break; + stbtt__csctx_rline_to(c, s[i], 0); + i++; + vlineto: + if (i >= sp) break; + stbtt__csctx_rline_to(c, 0, s[i]); + i++; + } + break; + + case 0x1F: // hvcurveto + if (sp < 4) return STBTT__CSERR("hvcurveto stack"); + goto hvcurveto; + case 0x1E: // vhcurveto + if (sp < 4) return STBTT__CSERR("vhcurveto stack"); + for (;;) { + if (i + 3 >= sp) break; + stbtt__csctx_rccurve_to(c, 0, s[i], s[i+1], s[i+2], s[i+3], (sp - i == 5) ? s[i + 4] : 0.0f); + i += 4; + hvcurveto: + if (i + 3 >= sp) break; + stbtt__csctx_rccurve_to(c, s[i], 0, s[i+1], s[i+2], (sp - i == 5) ? s[i+4] : 0.0f, s[i+3]); + i += 4; + } + break; + + case 0x08: // rrcurveto + if (sp < 6) return STBTT__CSERR("rcurveline stack"); + for (; i + 5 < sp; i += 6) + stbtt__csctx_rccurve_to(c, s[i], s[i+1], s[i+2], s[i+3], s[i+4], s[i+5]); + break; + + case 0x18: // rcurveline + if (sp < 8) return STBTT__CSERR("rcurveline stack"); + for (; i + 5 < sp - 2; i += 6) + stbtt__csctx_rccurve_to(c, s[i], s[i+1], s[i+2], s[i+3], s[i+4], s[i+5]); + if (i + 1 >= sp) return STBTT__CSERR("rcurveline stack"); + stbtt__csctx_rline_to(c, s[i], s[i+1]); + break; + + case 0x19: // rlinecurve + if (sp < 8) return STBTT__CSERR("rlinecurve stack"); + for (; i + 1 < sp - 6; i += 2) + stbtt__csctx_rline_to(c, s[i], s[i+1]); + if (i + 5 >= sp) return STBTT__CSERR("rlinecurve stack"); + stbtt__csctx_rccurve_to(c, s[i], s[i+1], s[i+2], s[i+3], s[i+4], s[i+5]); + break; + + case 0x1A: // vvcurveto + case 0x1B: // hhcurveto + if (sp < 4) return STBTT__CSERR("(vv|hh)curveto stack"); + f = 0.0; + if (sp & 1) { f = s[i]; i++; } + for (; i + 3 < sp; i += 4) { + if (b0 == 0x1B) + stbtt__csctx_rccurve_to(c, s[i], f, s[i+1], s[i+2], s[i+3], 0.0); + else + stbtt__csctx_rccurve_to(c, f, s[i], s[i+1], s[i+2], 0.0, s[i+3]); + f = 0.0; + } + break; + + case 0x0A: // callsubr + if (!has_subrs) { + if (info->fdselect.size) + subrs = stbtt__cid_get_glyph_subrs(info, glyph_index); + has_subrs = 1; + } + // fallthrough + case 0x1D: // callgsubr + if (sp < 1) return STBTT__CSERR("call(g|)subr stack"); + v = (int) s[--sp]; + if (subr_stack_height >= 10) return STBTT__CSERR("recursion limit"); + subr_stack[subr_stack_height++] = b; + b = stbtt__get_subr(b0 == 0x0A ? subrs : info->gsubrs, v); + if (b.size == 0) return STBTT__CSERR("subr not found"); + b.cursor = 0; + clear_stack = 0; + break; + + case 0x0B: // return + if (subr_stack_height <= 0) return STBTT__CSERR("return outside subr"); + b = subr_stack[--subr_stack_height]; + clear_stack = 0; + break; + + case 0x0E: // endchar + stbtt__csctx_close_shape(c); + return 1; + + case 0x0C: { // two-byte escape + float dx1, dx2, dx3, dx4, dx5, dx6, dy1, dy2, dy3, dy4, dy5, dy6; + float dx, dy; + int b1 = stbtt__buf_get8(&b); + switch (b1) { + // @TODO These "flex" implementations ignore the flex-depth and resolution, + // and always draw beziers. + case 0x22: // hflex + if (sp < 7) return STBTT__CSERR("hflex stack"); + dx1 = s[0]; + dx2 = s[1]; + dy2 = s[2]; + dx3 = s[3]; + dx4 = s[4]; + dx5 = s[5]; + dx6 = s[6]; + stbtt__csctx_rccurve_to(c, dx1, 0, dx2, dy2, dx3, 0); + stbtt__csctx_rccurve_to(c, dx4, 0, dx5, -dy2, dx6, 0); + break; + + case 0x23: // flex + if (sp < 13) return STBTT__CSERR("flex stack"); + dx1 = s[0]; + dy1 = s[1]; + dx2 = s[2]; + dy2 = s[3]; + dx3 = s[4]; + dy3 = s[5]; + dx4 = s[6]; + dy4 = s[7]; + dx5 = s[8]; + dy5 = s[9]; + dx6 = s[10]; + dy6 = s[11]; + //fd is s[12] + stbtt__csctx_rccurve_to(c, dx1, dy1, dx2, dy2, dx3, dy3); + stbtt__csctx_rccurve_to(c, dx4, dy4, dx5, dy5, dx6, dy6); + break; + + case 0x24: // hflex1 + if (sp < 9) return STBTT__CSERR("hflex1 stack"); + dx1 = s[0]; + dy1 = s[1]; + dx2 = s[2]; + dy2 = s[3]; + dx3 = s[4]; + dx4 = s[5]; + dx5 = s[6]; + dy5 = s[7]; + dx6 = s[8]; + stbtt__csctx_rccurve_to(c, dx1, dy1, dx2, dy2, dx3, 0); + stbtt__csctx_rccurve_to(c, dx4, 0, dx5, dy5, dx6, -(dy1+dy2+dy5)); + break; + + case 0x25: // flex1 + if (sp < 11) return STBTT__CSERR("flex1 stack"); + dx1 = s[0]; + dy1 = s[1]; + dx2 = s[2]; + dy2 = s[3]; + dx3 = s[4]; + dy3 = s[5]; + dx4 = s[6]; + dy4 = s[7]; + dx5 = s[8]; + dy5 = s[9]; + dx6 = dy6 = s[10]; + dx = dx1+dx2+dx3+dx4+dx5; + dy = dy1+dy2+dy3+dy4+dy5; + if (STBTT_fabs(dx) > STBTT_fabs(dy)) + dy6 = -dy; + else + dx6 = -dx; + stbtt__csctx_rccurve_to(c, dx1, dy1, dx2, dy2, dx3, dy3); + stbtt__csctx_rccurve_to(c, dx4, dy4, dx5, dy5, dx6, dy6); + break; + + default: + return STBTT__CSERR("unimplemented"); + } + } break; + + default: + if (b0 != 255 && b0 != 28 && (b0 < 32 || b0 > 254)) //-V560 + return STBTT__CSERR("reserved operator"); + + // push immediate + if (b0 == 255) { + f = (float)(stbtt_int32)stbtt__buf_get32(&b) / 0x10000; + } else { + stbtt__buf_skip(&b, -1); + f = (float)(stbtt_int16)stbtt__cff_int(&b); + } + if (sp >= 48) return STBTT__CSERR("push stack overflow"); + s[sp++] = f; + clear_stack = 0; + break; + } + if (clear_stack) sp = 0; + } + return STBTT__CSERR("no endchar"); + +#undef STBTT__CSERR +} + +static int stbtt__GetGlyphShapeT2(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int glyph_index, stbtt_vertex **pvertices) +{ + // runs the charstring twice, once to count and once to output (to avoid realloc) + stbtt__csctx count_ctx = STBTT__CSCTX_INIT(1); + stbtt__csctx output_ctx = STBTT__CSCTX_INIT(0); + if (stbtt__run_charstring(info, glyph_index, &count_ctx)) { + *pvertices = (stbtt_vertex*)STBTT_malloc(count_ctx.num_vertices*sizeof(stbtt_vertex), info->userdata); + output_ctx.pvertices = *pvertices; + if (stbtt__run_charstring(info, glyph_index, &output_ctx)) { + STBTT_assert(output_ctx.num_vertices == count_ctx.num_vertices); + return output_ctx.num_vertices; + } + } + *pvertices = NULL; + return 0; +} + +static int stbtt__GetGlyphInfoT2(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int glyph_index, int *x0, int *y0, int *x1, int *y1) +{ + stbtt__csctx c = STBTT__CSCTX_INIT(1); + int r = stbtt__run_charstring(info, glyph_index, &c); + if (x0) *x0 = r ? c.min_x : 0; + if (y0) *y0 = r ? c.min_y : 0; + if (x1) *x1 = r ? c.max_x : 0; + if (y1) *y1 = r ? c.max_y : 0; + return r ? c.num_vertices : 0; +} + +STBTT_DEF int stbtt_GetGlyphShape(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int glyph_index, stbtt_vertex **pvertices) +{ + if (!info->cff.size) + return stbtt__GetGlyphShapeTT(info, glyph_index, pvertices); + else + return stbtt__GetGlyphShapeT2(info, glyph_index, pvertices); +} + +STBTT_DEF void stbtt_GetGlyphHMetrics(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int glyph_index, int *advanceWidth, int *leftSideBearing) +{ + stbtt_uint16 numOfLongHorMetrics = ttUSHORT(info->data+info->hhea + 34); + if (glyph_index < numOfLongHorMetrics) { + if (advanceWidth) *advanceWidth = ttSHORT(info->data + info->hmtx + 4*glyph_index); + if (leftSideBearing) *leftSideBearing = ttSHORT(info->data + info->hmtx + 4*glyph_index + 2); + } else { + if (advanceWidth) *advanceWidth = ttSHORT(info->data + info->hmtx + 4*(numOfLongHorMetrics-1)); + if (leftSideBearing) *leftSideBearing = ttSHORT(info->data + info->hmtx + 4*numOfLongHorMetrics + 2*(glyph_index - numOfLongHorMetrics)); + } +} + +static int stbtt__GetGlyphKernInfoAdvance(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int glyph1, int glyph2) +{ + stbtt_uint8 *data = info->data + info->kern; + stbtt_uint32 needle, straw; + int l, r, m; + + // we only look at the first table. it must be 'horizontal' and format 0. + if (!info->kern) + return 0; + if (ttUSHORT(data+2) < 1) // number of tables, need at least 1 + return 0; + if (ttUSHORT(data+8) != 1) // horizontal flag must be set in format + return 0; + + l = 0; + r = ttUSHORT(data+10) - 1; + needle = glyph1 << 16 | glyph2; + while (l <= r) { + m = (l + r) >> 1; + straw = ttULONG(data+18+(m*6)); // note: unaligned read + if (needle < straw) + r = m - 1; + else if (needle > straw) + l = m + 1; + else + return ttSHORT(data+22+(m*6)); + } + return 0; +} + +static stbtt_int32 stbtt__GetCoverageIndex(stbtt_uint8 *coverageTable, int glyph) +{ + stbtt_uint16 coverageFormat = ttUSHORT(coverageTable); + switch(coverageFormat) { + case 1: { + stbtt_uint16 glyphCount = ttUSHORT(coverageTable + 2); + + // Binary search. + stbtt_int32 l=0, r=glyphCount-1, m; + int straw, needle=glyph; + while (l <= r) { + stbtt_uint8 *glyphArray = coverageTable + 4; + stbtt_uint16 glyphID; + m = (l + r) >> 1; + glyphID = ttUSHORT(glyphArray + 2 * m); + straw = glyphID; + if (needle < straw) + r = m - 1; + else if (needle > straw) + l = m + 1; + else { + return m; + } + } + } break; + + case 2: { + stbtt_uint16 rangeCount = ttUSHORT(coverageTable + 2); + stbtt_uint8 *rangeArray = coverageTable + 4; + + // Binary search. + stbtt_int32 l=0, r=rangeCount-1, m; + int strawStart, strawEnd, needle=glyph; + while (l <= r) { + stbtt_uint8 *rangeRecord; + m = (l + r) >> 1; + rangeRecord = rangeArray + 6 * m; + strawStart = ttUSHORT(rangeRecord); + strawEnd = ttUSHORT(rangeRecord + 2); + if (needle < strawStart) + r = m - 1; + else if (needle > strawEnd) + l = m + 1; + else { + stbtt_uint16 startCoverageIndex = ttUSHORT(rangeRecord + 4); + return startCoverageIndex + glyph - strawStart; + } + } + } break; + + default: { + // There are no other cases. + STBTT_assert(0); + } break; + } + + return -1; +} + +static stbtt_int32 stbtt__GetGlyphClass(stbtt_uint8 *classDefTable, int glyph) +{ + stbtt_uint16 classDefFormat = ttUSHORT(classDefTable); + switch(classDefFormat) + { + case 1: { + stbtt_uint16 startGlyphID = ttUSHORT(classDefTable + 2); + stbtt_uint16 glyphCount = ttUSHORT(classDefTable + 4); + stbtt_uint8 *classDef1ValueArray = classDefTable + 6; + + if (glyph >= startGlyphID && glyph < startGlyphID + glyphCount) + return (stbtt_int32)ttUSHORT(classDef1ValueArray + 2 * (glyph - startGlyphID)); + + // [DEAR IMGUI] Commented to fix static analyzer warning + //classDefTable = classDef1ValueArray + 2 * glyphCount; + } break; + + case 2: { + stbtt_uint16 classRangeCount = ttUSHORT(classDefTable + 2); + stbtt_uint8 *classRangeRecords = classDefTable + 4; + + // Binary search. + stbtt_int32 l=0, r=classRangeCount-1, m; + int strawStart, strawEnd, needle=glyph; + while (l <= r) { + stbtt_uint8 *classRangeRecord; + m = (l + r) >> 1; + classRangeRecord = classRangeRecords + 6 * m; + strawStart = ttUSHORT(classRangeRecord); + strawEnd = ttUSHORT(classRangeRecord + 2); + if (needle < strawStart) + r = m - 1; + else if (needle > strawEnd) + l = m + 1; + else + return (stbtt_int32)ttUSHORT(classRangeRecord + 4); + } + + // [DEAR IMGUI] Commented to fix static analyzer warning + //classDefTable = classRangeRecords + 6 * classRangeCount; + } break; + + default: { + // There are no other cases. + STBTT_assert(0); + } break; + } + + return -1; +} + +// Define to STBTT_assert(x) if you want to break on unimplemented formats. +#define STBTT_GPOS_TODO_assert(x) + +static stbtt_int32 stbtt__GetGlyphGPOSInfoAdvance(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int glyph1, int glyph2) +{ + stbtt_uint16 lookupListOffset; + stbtt_uint8 *lookupList; + stbtt_uint16 lookupCount; + stbtt_uint8 *data; + stbtt_int32 i; + + if (!info->gpos) return 0; + + data = info->data + info->gpos; + + if (ttUSHORT(data+0) != 1) return 0; // Major version 1 + if (ttUSHORT(data+2) != 0) return 0; // Minor version 0 + + lookupListOffset = ttUSHORT(data+8); + lookupList = data + lookupListOffset; + lookupCount = ttUSHORT(lookupList); + + for (i=0; i> 1; + pairValue = pairValueArray + (2 + valueRecordPairSizeInBytes) * m; + secondGlyph = ttUSHORT(pairValue); + straw = secondGlyph; + if (needle < straw) + r = m - 1; + else if (needle > straw) + l = m + 1; + else { + stbtt_int16 xAdvance = ttSHORT(pairValue + 2); + return xAdvance; + } + } + } break; + + case 2: { + stbtt_uint16 valueFormat1 = ttUSHORT(table + 4); + stbtt_uint16 valueFormat2 = ttUSHORT(table + 6); + + stbtt_uint16 classDef1Offset = ttUSHORT(table + 8); + stbtt_uint16 classDef2Offset = ttUSHORT(table + 10); + int glyph1class = stbtt__GetGlyphClass(table + classDef1Offset, glyph1); + int glyph2class = stbtt__GetGlyphClass(table + classDef2Offset, glyph2); + + stbtt_uint16 class1Count = ttUSHORT(table + 12); + stbtt_uint16 class2Count = ttUSHORT(table + 14); + STBTT_assert(glyph1class < class1Count); + STBTT_assert(glyph2class < class2Count); + + // TODO: Support more formats. + STBTT_GPOS_TODO_assert(valueFormat1 == 4); + if (valueFormat1 != 4) return 0; + STBTT_GPOS_TODO_assert(valueFormat2 == 0); + if (valueFormat2 != 0) return 0; + + if (glyph1class >= 0 && glyph1class < class1Count && glyph2class >= 0 && glyph2class < class2Count) { + stbtt_uint8 *class1Records = table + 16; + stbtt_uint8 *class2Records = class1Records + 2 * (glyph1class * class2Count); + stbtt_int16 xAdvance = ttSHORT(class2Records + 2 * glyph2class); + return xAdvance; + } + } break; + + default: { + // There are no other cases. + STBTT_assert(0); + break; + } // [DEAR IMGUI] removed ; + } + } + break; + } // [DEAR IMGUI] removed ; + + default: + // TODO: Implement other stuff. + break; + } + } + + return 0; +} + +STBTT_DEF int stbtt_GetGlyphKernAdvance(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int g1, int g2) +{ + int xAdvance = 0; + + if (info->gpos) + xAdvance += stbtt__GetGlyphGPOSInfoAdvance(info, g1, g2); + + if (info->kern) + xAdvance += stbtt__GetGlyphKernInfoAdvance(info, g1, g2); + + return xAdvance; +} + +STBTT_DEF int stbtt_GetCodepointKernAdvance(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int ch1, int ch2) +{ + if (!info->kern && !info->gpos) // if no kerning table, don't waste time looking up both codepoint->glyphs + return 0; + return stbtt_GetGlyphKernAdvance(info, stbtt_FindGlyphIndex(info,ch1), stbtt_FindGlyphIndex(info,ch2)); +} + +STBTT_DEF void stbtt_GetCodepointHMetrics(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int codepoint, int *advanceWidth, int *leftSideBearing) +{ + stbtt_GetGlyphHMetrics(info, stbtt_FindGlyphIndex(info,codepoint), advanceWidth, leftSideBearing); +} + +STBTT_DEF void stbtt_GetFontVMetrics(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int *ascent, int *descent, int *lineGap) +{ + if (ascent ) *ascent = ttSHORT(info->data+info->hhea + 4); + if (descent) *descent = ttSHORT(info->data+info->hhea + 6); + if (lineGap) *lineGap = ttSHORT(info->data+info->hhea + 8); +} + +STBTT_DEF int stbtt_GetFontVMetricsOS2(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int *typoAscent, int *typoDescent, int *typoLineGap) +{ + int tab = stbtt__find_table(info->data, info->fontstart, "OS/2"); + if (!tab) + return 0; + if (typoAscent ) *typoAscent = ttSHORT(info->data+tab + 68); + if (typoDescent) *typoDescent = ttSHORT(info->data+tab + 70); + if (typoLineGap) *typoLineGap = ttSHORT(info->data+tab + 72); + return 1; +} + +STBTT_DEF void stbtt_GetFontBoundingBox(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int *x0, int *y0, int *x1, int *y1) +{ + *x0 = ttSHORT(info->data + info->head + 36); + *y0 = ttSHORT(info->data + info->head + 38); + *x1 = ttSHORT(info->data + info->head + 40); + *y1 = ttSHORT(info->data + info->head + 42); +} + +STBTT_DEF float stbtt_ScaleForPixelHeight(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, float height) +{ + int fheight = ttSHORT(info->data + info->hhea + 4) - ttSHORT(info->data + info->hhea + 6); + return (float) height / fheight; +} + +STBTT_DEF float stbtt_ScaleForMappingEmToPixels(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, float pixels) +{ + int unitsPerEm = ttUSHORT(info->data + info->head + 18); + return pixels / unitsPerEm; +} + +STBTT_DEF void stbtt_FreeShape(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, stbtt_vertex *v) +{ + STBTT_free(v, info->userdata); +} + +////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +// +// antialiasing software rasterizer +// + +STBTT_DEF void stbtt_GetGlyphBitmapBoxSubpixel(const stbtt_fontinfo *font, int glyph, float scale_x, float scale_y,float shift_x, float shift_y, int *ix0, int *iy0, int *ix1, int *iy1) +{ + int x0=0,y0=0,x1,y1; // =0 suppresses compiler warning + if (!stbtt_GetGlyphBox(font, glyph, &x0,&y0,&x1,&y1)) { + // e.g. space character + if (ix0) *ix0 = 0; + if (iy0) *iy0 = 0; + if (ix1) *ix1 = 0; + if (iy1) *iy1 = 0; + } else { + // move to integral bboxes (treating pixels as little squares, what pixels get touched)? + if (ix0) *ix0 = STBTT_ifloor( x0 * scale_x + shift_x); + if (iy0) *iy0 = STBTT_ifloor(-y1 * scale_y + shift_y); + if (ix1) *ix1 = STBTT_iceil ( x1 * scale_x + shift_x); + if (iy1) *iy1 = STBTT_iceil (-y0 * scale_y + shift_y); + } +} + +STBTT_DEF void stbtt_GetGlyphBitmapBox(const stbtt_fontinfo *font, int glyph, float scale_x, float scale_y, int *ix0, int *iy0, int *ix1, int *iy1) +{ + stbtt_GetGlyphBitmapBoxSubpixel(font, glyph, scale_x, scale_y,0.0f,0.0f, ix0, iy0, ix1, iy1); +} + +STBTT_DEF void stbtt_GetCodepointBitmapBoxSubpixel(const stbtt_fontinfo *font, int codepoint, float scale_x, float scale_y, float shift_x, float shift_y, int *ix0, int *iy0, int *ix1, int *iy1) +{ + stbtt_GetGlyphBitmapBoxSubpixel(font, stbtt_FindGlyphIndex(font,codepoint), scale_x, scale_y,shift_x,shift_y, ix0,iy0,ix1,iy1); +} + +STBTT_DEF void stbtt_GetCodepointBitmapBox(const stbtt_fontinfo *font, int codepoint, float scale_x, float scale_y, int *ix0, int *iy0, int *ix1, int *iy1) +{ + stbtt_GetCodepointBitmapBoxSubpixel(font, codepoint, scale_x, scale_y,0.0f,0.0f, ix0,iy0,ix1,iy1); +} + +////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +// +// Rasterizer + +typedef struct stbtt__hheap_chunk +{ + struct stbtt__hheap_chunk *next; +} stbtt__hheap_chunk; + +typedef struct stbtt__hheap +{ + struct stbtt__hheap_chunk *head; + void *first_free; + int num_remaining_in_head_chunk; +} stbtt__hheap; + +static void *stbtt__hheap_alloc(stbtt__hheap *hh, size_t size, void *userdata) +{ + if (hh->first_free) { + void *p = hh->first_free; + hh->first_free = * (void **) p; + return p; + } else { + if (hh->num_remaining_in_head_chunk == 0) { + int count = (size < 32 ? 2000 : size < 128 ? 800 : 100); + stbtt__hheap_chunk *c = (stbtt__hheap_chunk *) STBTT_malloc(sizeof(stbtt__hheap_chunk) + size * count, userdata); + if (c == NULL) + return NULL; + c->next = hh->head; + hh->head = c; + hh->num_remaining_in_head_chunk = count; + } + --hh->num_remaining_in_head_chunk; + return (char *) (hh->head) + sizeof(stbtt__hheap_chunk) + size * hh->num_remaining_in_head_chunk; + } +} + +static void stbtt__hheap_free(stbtt__hheap *hh, void *p) +{ + *(void **) p = hh->first_free; + hh->first_free = p; +} + +static void stbtt__hheap_cleanup(stbtt__hheap *hh, void *userdata) +{ + stbtt__hheap_chunk *c = hh->head; + while (c) { + stbtt__hheap_chunk *n = c->next; + STBTT_free(c, userdata); + c = n; + } +} + +typedef struct stbtt__edge { + float x0,y0, x1,y1; + int invert; +} stbtt__edge; + + +typedef struct stbtt__active_edge +{ + struct stbtt__active_edge *next; + #if STBTT_RASTERIZER_VERSION==1 + int x,dx; + float ey; + int direction; + #elif STBTT_RASTERIZER_VERSION==2 + float fx,fdx,fdy; + float direction; + float sy; + float ey; + #else + #error "Unrecognized value of STBTT_RASTERIZER_VERSION" + #endif +} stbtt__active_edge; + +#if STBTT_RASTERIZER_VERSION == 1 +#define STBTT_FIXSHIFT 10 +#define STBTT_FIX (1 << STBTT_FIXSHIFT) +#define STBTT_FIXMASK (STBTT_FIX-1) + +static stbtt__active_edge *stbtt__new_active(stbtt__hheap *hh, stbtt__edge *e, int off_x, float start_point, void *userdata) +{ + stbtt__active_edge *z = (stbtt__active_edge *) stbtt__hheap_alloc(hh, sizeof(*z), userdata); + float dxdy = (e->x1 - e->x0) / (e->y1 - e->y0); + STBTT_assert(z != NULL); + if (!z) return z; + + // round dx down to avoid overshooting + if (dxdy < 0) + z->dx = -STBTT_ifloor(STBTT_FIX * -dxdy); + else + z->dx = STBTT_ifloor(STBTT_FIX * dxdy); + + z->x = STBTT_ifloor(STBTT_FIX * e->x0 + z->dx * (start_point - e->y0)); // use z->dx so when we offset later it's by the same amount + z->x -= off_x * STBTT_FIX; + + z->ey = e->y1; + z->next = 0; + z->direction = e->invert ? 1 : -1; + return z; +} +#elif STBTT_RASTERIZER_VERSION == 2 +static stbtt__active_edge *stbtt__new_active(stbtt__hheap *hh, stbtt__edge *e, int off_x, float start_point, void *userdata) +{ + stbtt__active_edge *z = (stbtt__active_edge *) stbtt__hheap_alloc(hh, sizeof(*z), userdata); + float dxdy = (e->x1 - e->x0) / (e->y1 - e->y0); + STBTT_assert(z != NULL); + //STBTT_assert(e->y0 <= start_point); + if (!z) return z; + z->fdx = dxdy; + z->fdy = dxdy != 0.0f ? (1.0f/dxdy) : 0.0f; + z->fx = e->x0 + dxdy * (start_point - e->y0); + z->fx -= off_x; + z->direction = e->invert ? 1.0f : -1.0f; + z->sy = e->y0; + z->ey = e->y1; + z->next = 0; + return z; +} +#else +#error "Unrecognized value of STBTT_RASTERIZER_VERSION" +#endif + +#if STBTT_RASTERIZER_VERSION == 1 +// note: this routine clips fills that extend off the edges... ideally this +// wouldn't happen, but it could happen if the truetype glyph bounding boxes +// are wrong, or if the user supplies a too-small bitmap +static void stbtt__fill_active_edges(unsigned char *scanline, int len, stbtt__active_edge *e, int max_weight) +{ + // non-zero winding fill + int x0=0, w=0; + + while (e) { + if (w == 0) { + // if we're currently at zero, we need to record the edge start point + x0 = e->x; w += e->direction; + } else { + int x1 = e->x; w += e->direction; + // if we went to zero, we need to draw + if (w == 0) { + int i = x0 >> STBTT_FIXSHIFT; + int j = x1 >> STBTT_FIXSHIFT; + + if (i < len && j >= 0) { + if (i == j) { + // x0,x1 are the same pixel, so compute combined coverage + scanline[i] = scanline[i] + (stbtt_uint8) ((x1 - x0) * max_weight >> STBTT_FIXSHIFT); + } else { + if (i >= 0) // add antialiasing for x0 + scanline[i] = scanline[i] + (stbtt_uint8) (((STBTT_FIX - (x0 & STBTT_FIXMASK)) * max_weight) >> STBTT_FIXSHIFT); + else + i = -1; // clip + + if (j < len) // add antialiasing for x1 + scanline[j] = scanline[j] + (stbtt_uint8) (((x1 & STBTT_FIXMASK) * max_weight) >> STBTT_FIXSHIFT); + else + j = len; // clip + + for (++i; i < j; ++i) // fill pixels between x0 and x1 + scanline[i] = scanline[i] + (stbtt_uint8) max_weight; + } + } + } + } + + e = e->next; + } +} + +static void stbtt__rasterize_sorted_edges(stbtt__bitmap *result, stbtt__edge *e, int n, int vsubsample, int off_x, int off_y, void *userdata) +{ + stbtt__hheap hh = { 0, 0, 0 }; + stbtt__active_edge *active = NULL; + int y,j=0; + int max_weight = (255 / vsubsample); // weight per vertical scanline + int s; // vertical subsample index + unsigned char scanline_data[512], *scanline; + + if (result->w > 512) + scanline = (unsigned char *) STBTT_malloc(result->w, userdata); + else + scanline = scanline_data; + + y = off_y * vsubsample; + e[n].y0 = (off_y + result->h) * (float) vsubsample + 1; + + while (j < result->h) { + STBTT_memset(scanline, 0, result->w); + for (s=0; s < vsubsample; ++s) { + // find center of pixel for this scanline + float scan_y = y + 0.5f; + stbtt__active_edge **step = &active; + + // update all active edges; + // remove all active edges that terminate before the center of this scanline + while (*step) { + stbtt__active_edge * z = *step; + if (z->ey <= scan_y) { + *step = z->next; // delete from list + STBTT_assert(z->direction); + z->direction = 0; + stbtt__hheap_free(&hh, z); + } else { + z->x += z->dx; // advance to position for current scanline + step = &((*step)->next); // advance through list + } + } + + // resort the list if needed + for(;;) { + int changed=0; + step = &active; + while (*step && (*step)->next) { + if ((*step)->x > (*step)->next->x) { + stbtt__active_edge *t = *step; + stbtt__active_edge *q = t->next; + + t->next = q->next; + q->next = t; + *step = q; + changed = 1; + } + step = &(*step)->next; + } + if (!changed) break; + } + + // insert all edges that start before the center of this scanline -- omit ones that also end on this scanline + while (e->y0 <= scan_y) { + if (e->y1 > scan_y) { + stbtt__active_edge *z = stbtt__new_active(&hh, e, off_x, scan_y, userdata); + if (z != NULL) { + // find insertion point + if (active == NULL) + active = z; + else if (z->x < active->x) { + // insert at front + z->next = active; + active = z; + } else { + // find thing to insert AFTER + stbtt__active_edge *p = active; + while (p->next && p->next->x < z->x) + p = p->next; + // at this point, p->next->x is NOT < z->x + z->next = p->next; + p->next = z; + } + } + } + ++e; + } + + // now process all active edges in XOR fashion + if (active) + stbtt__fill_active_edges(scanline, result->w, active, max_weight); + + ++y; + } + STBTT_memcpy(result->pixels + j * result->stride, scanline, result->w); + ++j; + } + + stbtt__hheap_cleanup(&hh, userdata); + + if (scanline != scanline_data) + STBTT_free(scanline, userdata); +} + +#elif STBTT_RASTERIZER_VERSION == 2 + +// the edge passed in here does not cross the vertical line at x or the vertical line at x+1 +// (i.e. it has already been clipped to those) +static void stbtt__handle_clipped_edge(float *scanline, int x, stbtt__active_edge *e, float x0, float y0, float x1, float y1) +{ + if (y0 == y1) return; + STBTT_assert(y0 < y1); + STBTT_assert(e->sy <= e->ey); + if (y0 > e->ey) return; + if (y1 < e->sy) return; + if (y0 < e->sy) { + x0 += (x1-x0) * (e->sy - y0) / (y1-y0); + y0 = e->sy; + } + if (y1 > e->ey) { + x1 += (x1-x0) * (e->ey - y1) / (y1-y0); + y1 = e->ey; + } + + if (x0 == x) + STBTT_assert(x1 <= x+1); + else if (x0 == x+1) + STBTT_assert(x1 >= x); + else if (x0 <= x) + STBTT_assert(x1 <= x); + else if (x0 >= x+1) + STBTT_assert(x1 >= x+1); + else + STBTT_assert(x1 >= x && x1 <= x+1); + + if (x0 <= x && x1 <= x) + scanline[x] += e->direction * (y1-y0); + else if (x0 >= x+1 && x1 >= x+1) + ; + else { + STBTT_assert(x0 >= x && x0 <= x+1 && x1 >= x && x1 <= x+1); + scanline[x] += e->direction * (y1-y0) * (1-((x0-x)+(x1-x))/2); // coverage = 1 - average x position + } +} + +static void stbtt__fill_active_edges_new(float *scanline, float *scanline_fill, int len, stbtt__active_edge *e, float y_top) +{ + float y_bottom = y_top+1; + + while (e) { + // brute force every pixel + + // compute intersection points with top & bottom + STBTT_assert(e->ey >= y_top); + + if (e->fdx == 0) { + float x0 = e->fx; + if (x0 < len) { + if (x0 >= 0) { + stbtt__handle_clipped_edge(scanline,(int) x0,e, x0,y_top, x0,y_bottom); + stbtt__handle_clipped_edge(scanline_fill-1,(int) x0+1,e, x0,y_top, x0,y_bottom); + } else { + stbtt__handle_clipped_edge(scanline_fill-1,0,e, x0,y_top, x0,y_bottom); + } + } + } else { + float x0 = e->fx; + float dx = e->fdx; + float xb = x0 + dx; + float x_top, x_bottom; + float sy0,sy1; + float dy = e->fdy; + STBTT_assert(e->sy <= y_bottom && e->ey >= y_top); + + // compute endpoints of line segment clipped to this scanline (if the + // line segment starts on this scanline. x0 is the intersection of the + // line with y_top, but that may be off the line segment. + if (e->sy > y_top) { + x_top = x0 + dx * (e->sy - y_top); + sy0 = e->sy; + } else { + x_top = x0; + sy0 = y_top; + } + if (e->ey < y_bottom) { + x_bottom = x0 + dx * (e->ey - y_top); + sy1 = e->ey; + } else { + x_bottom = xb; + sy1 = y_bottom; + } + + if (x_top >= 0 && x_bottom >= 0 && x_top < len && x_bottom < len) { + // from here on, we don't have to range check x values + + if ((int) x_top == (int) x_bottom) { + float height; + // simple case, only spans one pixel + int x = (int) x_top; + height = sy1 - sy0; + STBTT_assert(x >= 0 && x < len); + scanline[x] += e->direction * (1-((x_top - x) + (x_bottom-x))/2) * height; + scanline_fill[x] += e->direction * height; // everything right of this pixel is filled + } else { + int x,x1,x2; + float y_crossing, step, sign, area; + // covers 2+ pixels + if (x_top > x_bottom) { + // flip scanline vertically; signed area is the same + float t; + sy0 = y_bottom - (sy0 - y_top); + sy1 = y_bottom - (sy1 - y_top); + t = sy0, sy0 = sy1, sy1 = t; + t = x_bottom, x_bottom = x_top, x_top = t; + dx = -dx; + dy = -dy; + t = x0, x0 = xb, xb = t; + // [DEAR IMGUI] Fix static analyzer warning + (void)dx; // [ImGui: fix static analyzer warning] + } + + x1 = (int) x_top; + x2 = (int) x_bottom; + // compute intersection with y axis at x1+1 + y_crossing = (x1+1 - x0) * dy + y_top; + + sign = e->direction; + // area of the rectangle covered from y0..y_crossing + area = sign * (y_crossing-sy0); + // area of the triangle (x_top,y0), (x+1,y0), (x+1,y_crossing) + scanline[x1] += area * (1-((x_top - x1)+(x1+1-x1))/2); + + step = sign * dy; + for (x = x1+1; x < x2; ++x) { + scanline[x] += area + step/2; + area += step; + } + y_crossing += dy * (x2 - (x1+1)); + + STBTT_assert(STBTT_fabs(area) <= 1.01f); + + scanline[x2] += area + sign * (1-((x2-x2)+(x_bottom-x2))/2) * (sy1-y_crossing); + + scanline_fill[x2] += sign * (sy1-sy0); + } + } else { + // if edge goes outside of box we're drawing, we require + // clipping logic. since this does not match the intended use + // of this library, we use a different, very slow brute + // force implementation + int x; + for (x=0; x < len; ++x) { + // cases: + // + // there can be up to two intersections with the pixel. any intersection + // with left or right edges can be handled by splitting into two (or three) + // regions. intersections with top & bottom do not necessitate case-wise logic. + // + // the old way of doing this found the intersections with the left & right edges, + // then used some simple logic to produce up to three segments in sorted order + // from top-to-bottom. however, this had a problem: if an x edge was epsilon + // across the x border, then the corresponding y position might not be distinct + // from the other y segment, and it might ignored as an empty segment. to avoid + // that, we need to explicitly produce segments based on x positions. + + // rename variables to clearly-defined pairs + float y0 = y_top; + float x1 = (float) (x); + float x2 = (float) (x+1); + float x3 = xb; + float y3 = y_bottom; + + // x = e->x + e->dx * (y-y_top) + // (y-y_top) = (x - e->x) / e->dx + // y = (x - e->x) / e->dx + y_top + float y1 = (x - x0) / dx + y_top; + float y2 = (x+1 - x0) / dx + y_top; + + if (x0 < x1 && x3 > x2) { // three segments descending down-right + stbtt__handle_clipped_edge(scanline,x,e, x0,y0, x1,y1); + stbtt__handle_clipped_edge(scanline,x,e, x1,y1, x2,y2); + stbtt__handle_clipped_edge(scanline,x,e, x2,y2, x3,y3); + } else if (x3 < x1 && x0 > x2) { // three segments descending down-left + stbtt__handle_clipped_edge(scanline,x,e, x0,y0, x2,y2); + stbtt__handle_clipped_edge(scanline,x,e, x2,y2, x1,y1); + stbtt__handle_clipped_edge(scanline,x,e, x1,y1, x3,y3); + } else if (x0 < x1 && x3 > x1) { // two segments across x, down-right + stbtt__handle_clipped_edge(scanline,x,e, x0,y0, x1,y1); + stbtt__handle_clipped_edge(scanline,x,e, x1,y1, x3,y3); + } else if (x3 < x1 && x0 > x1) { // two segments across x, down-left + stbtt__handle_clipped_edge(scanline,x,e, x0,y0, x1,y1); + stbtt__handle_clipped_edge(scanline,x,e, x1,y1, x3,y3); + } else if (x0 < x2 && x3 > x2) { // two segments across x+1, down-right + stbtt__handle_clipped_edge(scanline,x,e, x0,y0, x2,y2); + stbtt__handle_clipped_edge(scanline,x,e, x2,y2, x3,y3); + } else if (x3 < x2 && x0 > x2) { // two segments across x+1, down-left + stbtt__handle_clipped_edge(scanline,x,e, x0,y0, x2,y2); + stbtt__handle_clipped_edge(scanline,x,e, x2,y2, x3,y3); + } else { // one segment + stbtt__handle_clipped_edge(scanline,x,e, x0,y0, x3,y3); + } + } + } + } + e = e->next; + } +} + +// directly AA rasterize edges w/o supersampling +static void stbtt__rasterize_sorted_edges(stbtt__bitmap *result, stbtt__edge *e, int n, int vsubsample, int off_x, int off_y, void *userdata) +{ + stbtt__hheap hh = { 0, 0, 0 }; + stbtt__active_edge *active = NULL; + int y,j=0, i; + float scanline_data[129], *scanline, *scanline2; + + STBTT__NOTUSED(vsubsample); + + if (result->w > 64) + scanline = (float *) STBTT_malloc((result->w*2+1) * sizeof(float), userdata); + else + scanline = scanline_data; + + scanline2 = scanline + result->w; + + y = off_y; + e[n].y0 = (float) (off_y + result->h) + 1; + + while (j < result->h) { + // find center of pixel for this scanline + float scan_y_top = y + 0.0f; + float scan_y_bottom = y + 1.0f; + stbtt__active_edge **step = &active; + + STBTT_memset(scanline , 0, result->w*sizeof(scanline[0])); + STBTT_memset(scanline2, 0, (result->w+1)*sizeof(scanline[0])); + + // update all active edges; + // remove all active edges that terminate before the top of this scanline + while (*step) { + stbtt__active_edge * z = *step; + if (z->ey <= scan_y_top) { + *step = z->next; // delete from list + STBTT_assert(z->direction); + z->direction = 0; + stbtt__hheap_free(&hh, z); + } else { + step = &((*step)->next); // advance through list + } + } + + // insert all edges that start before the bottom of this scanline + while (e->y0 <= scan_y_bottom) { + if (e->y0 != e->y1) { + stbtt__active_edge *z = stbtt__new_active(&hh, e, off_x, scan_y_top, userdata); + if (z != NULL) { + if (j == 0 && off_y != 0) { + if (z->ey < scan_y_top) { + // this can happen due to subpixel positioning and some kind of fp rounding error i think + z->ey = scan_y_top; + } + } + STBTT_assert(z->ey >= scan_y_top); // if we get really unlucky a tiny bit of an edge can be out of bounds + // insert at front + z->next = active; + active = z; + } + } + ++e; + } + + // now process all active edges + if (active) + stbtt__fill_active_edges_new(scanline, scanline2+1, result->w, active, scan_y_top); + + { + float sum = 0; + for (i=0; i < result->w; ++i) { + float k; + int m; + sum += scanline2[i]; + k = scanline[i] + sum; + k = (float) STBTT_fabs(k)*255 + 0.5f; + m = (int) k; + if (m > 255) m = 255; + result->pixels[j*result->stride + i] = (unsigned char) m; + } + } + // advance all the edges + step = &active; + while (*step) { + stbtt__active_edge *z = *step; + z->fx += z->fdx; // advance to position for current scanline + step = &((*step)->next); // advance through list + } + + ++y; + ++j; + } + + stbtt__hheap_cleanup(&hh, userdata); + + if (scanline != scanline_data) + STBTT_free(scanline, userdata); +} +#else +#error "Unrecognized value of STBTT_RASTERIZER_VERSION" +#endif + +#define STBTT__COMPARE(a,b) ((a)->y0 < (b)->y0) + +static void stbtt__sort_edges_ins_sort(stbtt__edge *p, int n) +{ + int i,j; + for (i=1; i < n; ++i) { + stbtt__edge t = p[i], *a = &t; + j = i; + while (j > 0) { + stbtt__edge *b = &p[j-1]; + int c = STBTT__COMPARE(a,b); + if (!c) break; + p[j] = p[j-1]; + --j; + } + if (i != j) + p[j] = t; + } +} + +static void stbtt__sort_edges_quicksort(stbtt__edge *p, int n) +{ + /* threshold for transitioning to insertion sort */ + while (n > 12) { + stbtt__edge t; + int c01,c12,c,m,i,j; + + /* compute median of three */ + m = n >> 1; + c01 = STBTT__COMPARE(&p[0],&p[m]); + c12 = STBTT__COMPARE(&p[m],&p[n-1]); + /* if 0 >= mid >= end, or 0 < mid < end, then use mid */ + if (c01 != c12) { + /* otherwise, we'll need to swap something else to middle */ + int z; + c = STBTT__COMPARE(&p[0],&p[n-1]); + /* 0>mid && midn => n; 0 0 */ + /* 0n: 0>n => 0; 0 n */ + z = (c == c12) ? 0 : n-1; + t = p[z]; + p[z] = p[m]; + p[m] = t; + } + /* now p[m] is the median-of-three */ + /* swap it to the beginning so it won't move around */ + t = p[0]; + p[0] = p[m]; + p[m] = t; + + /* partition loop */ + i=1; + j=n-1; + for(;;) { + /* handling of equality is crucial here */ + /* for sentinels & efficiency with duplicates */ + for (;;++i) { + if (!STBTT__COMPARE(&p[i], &p[0])) break; + } + for (;;--j) { + if (!STBTT__COMPARE(&p[0], &p[j])) break; + } + /* make sure we haven't crossed */ + if (i >= j) break; + t = p[i]; + p[i] = p[j]; + p[j] = t; + + ++i; + --j; + } + /* recurse on smaller side, iterate on larger */ + if (j < (n-i)) { + stbtt__sort_edges_quicksort(p,j); + p = p+i; + n = n-i; + } else { + stbtt__sort_edges_quicksort(p+i, n-i); + n = j; + } + } +} + +static void stbtt__sort_edges(stbtt__edge *p, int n) +{ + stbtt__sort_edges_quicksort(p, n); + stbtt__sort_edges_ins_sort(p, n); +} + +typedef struct +{ + float x,y; +} stbtt__point; + +static void stbtt__rasterize(stbtt__bitmap *result, stbtt__point *pts, int *wcount, int windings, float scale_x, float scale_y, float shift_x, float shift_y, int off_x, int off_y, int invert, void *userdata) +{ + float y_scale_inv = invert ? -scale_y : scale_y; + stbtt__edge *e; + int n,i,j,k,m; +#if STBTT_RASTERIZER_VERSION == 1 + int vsubsample = result->h < 8 ? 15 : 5; +#elif STBTT_RASTERIZER_VERSION == 2 + int vsubsample = 1; +#else + #error "Unrecognized value of STBTT_RASTERIZER_VERSION" +#endif + // vsubsample should divide 255 evenly; otherwise we won't reach full opacity + + // now we have to blow out the windings into explicit edge lists + n = 0; + for (i=0; i < windings; ++i) + n += wcount[i]; + + e = (stbtt__edge *) STBTT_malloc(sizeof(*e) * (n+1), userdata); // add an extra one as a sentinel + if (e == 0) return; + n = 0; + + m=0; + for (i=0; i < windings; ++i) { + stbtt__point *p = pts + m; + m += wcount[i]; + j = wcount[i]-1; + for (k=0; k < wcount[i]; j=k++) { + int a=k,b=j; + // skip the edge if horizontal + if (p[j].y == p[k].y) + continue; + // add edge from j to k to the list + e[n].invert = 0; + if (invert ? p[j].y > p[k].y : p[j].y < p[k].y) { + e[n].invert = 1; + a=j,b=k; + } + e[n].x0 = p[a].x * scale_x + shift_x; + e[n].y0 = (p[a].y * y_scale_inv + shift_y) * vsubsample; + e[n].x1 = p[b].x * scale_x + shift_x; + e[n].y1 = (p[b].y * y_scale_inv + shift_y) * vsubsample; + ++n; + } + } + + // now sort the edges by their highest point (should snap to integer, and then by x) + //STBTT_sort(e, n, sizeof(e[0]), stbtt__edge_compare); + stbtt__sort_edges(e, n); + + // now, traverse the scanlines and find the intersections on each scanline, use xor winding rule + stbtt__rasterize_sorted_edges(result, e, n, vsubsample, off_x, off_y, userdata); + + STBTT_free(e, userdata); +} + +static void stbtt__add_point(stbtt__point *points, int n, float x, float y) +{ + if (!points) return; // during first pass, it's unallocated + points[n].x = x; + points[n].y = y; +} + +// tessellate until threshold p is happy... @TODO warped to compensate for non-linear stretching +static int stbtt__tesselate_curve(stbtt__point *points, int *num_points, float x0, float y0, float x1, float y1, float x2, float y2, float objspace_flatness_squared, int n) +{ + // midpoint + float mx = (x0 + 2*x1 + x2)/4; + float my = (y0 + 2*y1 + y2)/4; + // versus directly drawn line + float dx = (x0+x2)/2 - mx; + float dy = (y0+y2)/2 - my; + if (n > 16) // 65536 segments on one curve better be enough! + return 1; + if (dx*dx+dy*dy > objspace_flatness_squared) { // half-pixel error allowed... need to be smaller if AA + stbtt__tesselate_curve(points, num_points, x0,y0, (x0+x1)/2.0f,(y0+y1)/2.0f, mx,my, objspace_flatness_squared,n+1); + stbtt__tesselate_curve(points, num_points, mx,my, (x1+x2)/2.0f,(y1+y2)/2.0f, x2,y2, objspace_flatness_squared,n+1); + } else { + stbtt__add_point(points, *num_points,x2,y2); + *num_points = *num_points+1; + } + return 1; +} + +static void stbtt__tesselate_cubic(stbtt__point *points, int *num_points, float x0, float y0, float x1, float y1, float x2, float y2, float x3, float y3, float objspace_flatness_squared, int n) +{ + // @TODO this "flatness" calculation is just made-up nonsense that seems to work well enough + float dx0 = x1-x0; + float dy0 = y1-y0; + float dx1 = x2-x1; + float dy1 = y2-y1; + float dx2 = x3-x2; + float dy2 = y3-y2; + float dx = x3-x0; + float dy = y3-y0; + float longlen = (float) (STBTT_sqrt(dx0*dx0+dy0*dy0)+STBTT_sqrt(dx1*dx1+dy1*dy1)+STBTT_sqrt(dx2*dx2+dy2*dy2)); + float shortlen = (float) STBTT_sqrt(dx*dx+dy*dy); + float flatness_squared = longlen*longlen-shortlen*shortlen; + + if (n > 16) // 65536 segments on one curve better be enough! + return; + + if (flatness_squared > objspace_flatness_squared) { + float x01 = (x0+x1)/2; + float y01 = (y0+y1)/2; + float x12 = (x1+x2)/2; + float y12 = (y1+y2)/2; + float x23 = (x2+x3)/2; + float y23 = (y2+y3)/2; + + float xa = (x01+x12)/2; + float ya = (y01+y12)/2; + float xb = (x12+x23)/2; + float yb = (y12+y23)/2; + + float mx = (xa+xb)/2; + float my = (ya+yb)/2; + + stbtt__tesselate_cubic(points, num_points, x0,y0, x01,y01, xa,ya, mx,my, objspace_flatness_squared,n+1); + stbtt__tesselate_cubic(points, num_points, mx,my, xb,yb, x23,y23, x3,y3, objspace_flatness_squared,n+1); + } else { + stbtt__add_point(points, *num_points,x3,y3); + *num_points = *num_points+1; + } +} + +// returns number of contours +static stbtt__point *stbtt_FlattenCurves(stbtt_vertex *vertices, int num_verts, float objspace_flatness, int **contour_lengths, int *num_contours, void *userdata) +{ + stbtt__point *points=0; + int num_points=0; + + float objspace_flatness_squared = objspace_flatness * objspace_flatness; + int i,n=0,start=0, pass; + + // count how many "moves" there are to get the contour count + for (i=0; i < num_verts; ++i) + if (vertices[i].type == STBTT_vmove) + ++n; + + *num_contours = n; + if (n == 0) return 0; + + *contour_lengths = (int *) STBTT_malloc(sizeof(**contour_lengths) * n, userdata); + + if (*contour_lengths == 0) { + *num_contours = 0; + return 0; + } + + // make two passes through the points so we don't need to realloc + for (pass=0; pass < 2; ++pass) { + float x=0,y=0; + if (pass == 1) { + points = (stbtt__point *) STBTT_malloc(num_points * sizeof(points[0]), userdata); + if (points == NULL) goto error; + } + num_points = 0; + n= -1; + for (i=0; i < num_verts; ++i) { + switch (vertices[i].type) { + case STBTT_vmove: + // start the next contour + if (n >= 0) + (*contour_lengths)[n] = num_points - start; + ++n; + start = num_points; + + x = vertices[i].x, y = vertices[i].y; + stbtt__add_point(points, num_points++, x,y); + break; + case STBTT_vline: + x = vertices[i].x, y = vertices[i].y; + stbtt__add_point(points, num_points++, x, y); + break; + case STBTT_vcurve: + stbtt__tesselate_curve(points, &num_points, x,y, + vertices[i].cx, vertices[i].cy, + vertices[i].x, vertices[i].y, + objspace_flatness_squared, 0); + x = vertices[i].x, y = vertices[i].y; + break; + case STBTT_vcubic: + stbtt__tesselate_cubic(points, &num_points, x,y, + vertices[i].cx, vertices[i].cy, + vertices[i].cx1, vertices[i].cy1, + vertices[i].x, vertices[i].y, + objspace_flatness_squared, 0); + x = vertices[i].x, y = vertices[i].y; + break; + } + } + (*contour_lengths)[n] = num_points - start; + } + + return points; +error: + STBTT_free(points, userdata); + STBTT_free(*contour_lengths, userdata); + *contour_lengths = 0; + *num_contours = 0; + return NULL; +} + +STBTT_DEF void stbtt_Rasterize(stbtt__bitmap *result, float flatness_in_pixels, stbtt_vertex *vertices, int num_verts, float scale_x, float scale_y, float shift_x, float shift_y, int x_off, int y_off, int invert, void *userdata) +{ + float scale = scale_x > scale_y ? scale_y : scale_x; + int winding_count = 0; + int *winding_lengths = NULL; + stbtt__point *windings = stbtt_FlattenCurves(vertices, num_verts, flatness_in_pixels / scale, &winding_lengths, &winding_count, userdata); + if (windings) { + stbtt__rasterize(result, windings, winding_lengths, winding_count, scale_x, scale_y, shift_x, shift_y, x_off, y_off, invert, userdata); + STBTT_free(winding_lengths, userdata); + STBTT_free(windings, userdata); + } +} + +STBTT_DEF void stbtt_FreeBitmap(unsigned char *bitmap, void *userdata) +{ + STBTT_free(bitmap, userdata); +} + +STBTT_DEF unsigned char *stbtt_GetGlyphBitmapSubpixel(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, float scale_x, float scale_y, float shift_x, float shift_y, int glyph, int *width, int *height, int *xoff, int *yoff) +{ + int ix0,iy0,ix1,iy1; + stbtt__bitmap gbm; + stbtt_vertex *vertices; + int num_verts = stbtt_GetGlyphShape(info, glyph, &vertices); + + if (scale_x == 0) scale_x = scale_y; + if (scale_y == 0) { + if (scale_x == 0) { + STBTT_free(vertices, info->userdata); + return NULL; + } + scale_y = scale_x; + } + + stbtt_GetGlyphBitmapBoxSubpixel(info, glyph, scale_x, scale_y, shift_x, shift_y, &ix0,&iy0,&ix1,&iy1); + + // now we get the size + gbm.w = (ix1 - ix0); + gbm.h = (iy1 - iy0); + gbm.pixels = NULL; // in case we error + + if (width ) *width = gbm.w; + if (height) *height = gbm.h; + if (xoff ) *xoff = ix0; + if (yoff ) *yoff = iy0; + + if (gbm.w && gbm.h) { + gbm.pixels = (unsigned char *) STBTT_malloc(gbm.w * gbm.h, info->userdata); + if (gbm.pixels) { + gbm.stride = gbm.w; + + stbtt_Rasterize(&gbm, 0.35f, vertices, num_verts, scale_x, scale_y, shift_x, shift_y, ix0, iy0, 1, info->userdata); + } + } + STBTT_free(vertices, info->userdata); + return gbm.pixels; +} + +STBTT_DEF unsigned char *stbtt_GetGlyphBitmap(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, float scale_x, float scale_y, int glyph, int *width, int *height, int *xoff, int *yoff) +{ + return stbtt_GetGlyphBitmapSubpixel(info, scale_x, scale_y, 0.0f, 0.0f, glyph, width, height, xoff, yoff); +} + +STBTT_DEF void stbtt_MakeGlyphBitmapSubpixel(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, unsigned char *output, int out_w, int out_h, int out_stride, float scale_x, float scale_y, float shift_x, float shift_y, int glyph) +{ + int ix0,iy0; + stbtt_vertex *vertices; + int num_verts = stbtt_GetGlyphShape(info, glyph, &vertices); + stbtt__bitmap gbm; + + stbtt_GetGlyphBitmapBoxSubpixel(info, glyph, scale_x, scale_y, shift_x, shift_y, &ix0,&iy0,0,0); + gbm.pixels = output; + gbm.w = out_w; + gbm.h = out_h; + gbm.stride = out_stride; + + if (gbm.w && gbm.h) + stbtt_Rasterize(&gbm, 0.35f, vertices, num_verts, scale_x, scale_y, shift_x, shift_y, ix0,iy0, 1, info->userdata); + + STBTT_free(vertices, info->userdata); +} + +STBTT_DEF void stbtt_MakeGlyphBitmap(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, unsigned char *output, int out_w, int out_h, int out_stride, float scale_x, float scale_y, int glyph) +{ + stbtt_MakeGlyphBitmapSubpixel(info, output, out_w, out_h, out_stride, scale_x, scale_y, 0.0f,0.0f, glyph); +} + +STBTT_DEF unsigned char *stbtt_GetCodepointBitmapSubpixel(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, float scale_x, float scale_y, float shift_x, float shift_y, int codepoint, int *width, int *height, int *xoff, int *yoff) +{ + return stbtt_GetGlyphBitmapSubpixel(info, scale_x, scale_y,shift_x,shift_y, stbtt_FindGlyphIndex(info,codepoint), width,height,xoff,yoff); +} + +STBTT_DEF void stbtt_MakeCodepointBitmapSubpixelPrefilter(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, unsigned char *output, int out_w, int out_h, int out_stride, float scale_x, float scale_y, float shift_x, float shift_y, int oversample_x, int oversample_y, float *sub_x, float *sub_y, int codepoint) +{ + stbtt_MakeGlyphBitmapSubpixelPrefilter(info, output, out_w, out_h, out_stride, scale_x, scale_y, shift_x, shift_y, oversample_x, oversample_y, sub_x, sub_y, stbtt_FindGlyphIndex(info,codepoint)); +} + +STBTT_DEF void stbtt_MakeCodepointBitmapSubpixel(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, unsigned char *output, int out_w, int out_h, int out_stride, float scale_x, float scale_y, float shift_x, float shift_y, int codepoint) +{ + stbtt_MakeGlyphBitmapSubpixel(info, output, out_w, out_h, out_stride, scale_x, scale_y, shift_x, shift_y, stbtt_FindGlyphIndex(info,codepoint)); +} + +STBTT_DEF unsigned char *stbtt_GetCodepointBitmap(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, float scale_x, float scale_y, int codepoint, int *width, int *height, int *xoff, int *yoff) +{ + return stbtt_GetCodepointBitmapSubpixel(info, scale_x, scale_y, 0.0f,0.0f, codepoint, width,height,xoff,yoff); +} + +STBTT_DEF void stbtt_MakeCodepointBitmap(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, unsigned char *output, int out_w, int out_h, int out_stride, float scale_x, float scale_y, int codepoint) +{ + stbtt_MakeCodepointBitmapSubpixel(info, output, out_w, out_h, out_stride, scale_x, scale_y, 0.0f,0.0f, codepoint); +} + +////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +// +// bitmap baking +// +// This is SUPER-CRAPPY packing to keep source code small + +static int stbtt_BakeFontBitmap_internal(unsigned char *data, int offset, // font location (use offset=0 for plain .ttf) + float pixel_height, // height of font in pixels + unsigned char *pixels, int pw, int ph, // bitmap to be filled in + int first_char, int num_chars, // characters to bake + stbtt_bakedchar *chardata) +{ + float scale; + int x,y,bottom_y, i; + stbtt_fontinfo f; + f.userdata = NULL; + if (!stbtt_InitFont(&f, data, offset)) + return -1; + STBTT_memset(pixels, 0, pw*ph); // background of 0 around pixels + x=y=1; + bottom_y = 1; + + scale = stbtt_ScaleForPixelHeight(&f, pixel_height); + + for (i=0; i < num_chars; ++i) { + int advance, lsb, x0,y0,x1,y1,gw,gh; + int g = stbtt_FindGlyphIndex(&f, first_char + i); + stbtt_GetGlyphHMetrics(&f, g, &advance, &lsb); + stbtt_GetGlyphBitmapBox(&f, g, scale,scale, &x0,&y0,&x1,&y1); + gw = x1-x0; + gh = y1-y0; + if (x + gw + 1 >= pw) + y = bottom_y, x = 1; // advance to next row + if (y + gh + 1 >= ph) // check if it fits vertically AFTER potentially moving to next row + return -i; + STBTT_assert(x+gw < pw); + STBTT_assert(y+gh < ph); + stbtt_MakeGlyphBitmap(&f, pixels+x+y*pw, gw,gh,pw, scale,scale, g); + chardata[i].x0 = (stbtt_int16) x; + chardata[i].y0 = (stbtt_int16) y; + chardata[i].x1 = (stbtt_int16) (x + gw); + chardata[i].y1 = (stbtt_int16) (y + gh); + chardata[i].xadvance = scale * advance; + chardata[i].xoff = (float) x0; + chardata[i].yoff = (float) y0; + x = x + gw + 1; + if (y+gh+1 > bottom_y) + bottom_y = y+gh+1; + } + return bottom_y; +} + +STBTT_DEF void stbtt_GetBakedQuad(const stbtt_bakedchar *chardata, int pw, int ph, int char_index, float *xpos, float *ypos, stbtt_aligned_quad *q, int opengl_fillrule) +{ + float d3d_bias = opengl_fillrule ? 0 : -0.5f; + float ipw = 1.0f / pw, iph = 1.0f / ph; + const stbtt_bakedchar *b = chardata + char_index; + int round_x = STBTT_ifloor((*xpos + b->xoff) + 0.5f); + int round_y = STBTT_ifloor((*ypos + b->yoff) + 0.5f); + + q->x0 = round_x + d3d_bias; + q->y0 = round_y + d3d_bias; + q->x1 = round_x + b->x1 - b->x0 + d3d_bias; + q->y1 = round_y + b->y1 - b->y0 + d3d_bias; + + q->s0 = b->x0 * ipw; + q->t0 = b->y0 * iph; + q->s1 = b->x1 * ipw; + q->t1 = b->y1 * iph; + + *xpos += b->xadvance; +} + +////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +// +// rectangle packing replacement routines if you don't have stb_rect_pack.h +// + +#ifndef STB_RECT_PACK_VERSION + +typedef int stbrp_coord; + +//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +// // +// // +// COMPILER WARNING ?!?!? // +// // +// // +// if you get a compile warning due to these symbols being defined more than // +// once, move #include "stb_rect_pack.h" before #include "stb_truetype.h" // +// // +//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// + +typedef struct +{ + int width,height; + int x,y,bottom_y; +} stbrp_context; + +typedef struct +{ + unsigned char x; +} stbrp_node; + +struct stbrp_rect +{ + stbrp_coord x,y; + int id,w,h,was_packed; +}; + +static void stbrp_init_target(stbrp_context *con, int pw, int ph, stbrp_node *nodes, int num_nodes) +{ + con->width = pw; + con->height = ph; + con->x = 0; + con->y = 0; + con->bottom_y = 0; + STBTT__NOTUSED(nodes); + STBTT__NOTUSED(num_nodes); +} + +static void stbrp_pack_rects(stbrp_context *con, stbrp_rect *rects, int num_rects) +{ + int i; + for (i=0; i < num_rects; ++i) { + if (con->x + rects[i].w > con->width) { + con->x = 0; + con->y = con->bottom_y; + } + if (con->y + rects[i].h > con->height) + break; + rects[i].x = con->x; + rects[i].y = con->y; + rects[i].was_packed = 1; + con->x += rects[i].w; + if (con->y + rects[i].h > con->bottom_y) + con->bottom_y = con->y + rects[i].h; + } + for ( ; i < num_rects; ++i) + rects[i].was_packed = 0; +} +#endif + +////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +// +// bitmap baking +// +// This is SUPER-AWESOME (tm Ryan Gordon) packing using stb_rect_pack.h. If +// stb_rect_pack.h isn't available, it uses the BakeFontBitmap strategy. + +STBTT_DEF int stbtt_PackBegin(stbtt_pack_context *spc, unsigned char *pixels, int pw, int ph, int stride_in_bytes, int padding, void *alloc_context) +{ + stbrp_context *context = (stbrp_context *) STBTT_malloc(sizeof(*context) ,alloc_context); + int num_nodes = pw - padding; + stbrp_node *nodes = (stbrp_node *) STBTT_malloc(sizeof(*nodes ) * num_nodes,alloc_context); + + if (context == NULL || nodes == NULL) { + if (context != NULL) STBTT_free(context, alloc_context); + if (nodes != NULL) STBTT_free(nodes , alloc_context); + return 0; + } + + spc->user_allocator_context = alloc_context; + spc->width = pw; + spc->height = ph; + spc->pixels = pixels; + spc->pack_info = context; + spc->nodes = nodes; + spc->padding = padding; + spc->stride_in_bytes = stride_in_bytes != 0 ? stride_in_bytes : pw; + spc->h_oversample = 1; + spc->v_oversample = 1; + spc->skip_missing = 0; + + stbrp_init_target(context, pw-padding, ph-padding, nodes, num_nodes); + + if (pixels) + STBTT_memset(pixels, 0, pw*ph); // background of 0 around pixels + + return 1; +} + +STBTT_DEF void stbtt_PackEnd (stbtt_pack_context *spc) +{ + STBTT_free(spc->nodes , spc->user_allocator_context); + STBTT_free(spc->pack_info, spc->user_allocator_context); +} + +STBTT_DEF void stbtt_PackSetOversampling(stbtt_pack_context *spc, unsigned int h_oversample, unsigned int v_oversample) +{ + STBTT_assert(h_oversample <= STBTT_MAX_OVERSAMPLE); + STBTT_assert(v_oversample <= STBTT_MAX_OVERSAMPLE); + if (h_oversample <= STBTT_MAX_OVERSAMPLE) + spc->h_oversample = h_oversample; + if (v_oversample <= STBTT_MAX_OVERSAMPLE) + spc->v_oversample = v_oversample; +} + +STBTT_DEF void stbtt_PackSetSkipMissingCodepoints(stbtt_pack_context *spc, int skip) +{ + spc->skip_missing = skip; +} + +#define STBTT__OVER_MASK (STBTT_MAX_OVERSAMPLE-1) + +static void stbtt__h_prefilter(unsigned char *pixels, int w, int h, int stride_in_bytes, unsigned int kernel_width) +{ + unsigned char buffer[STBTT_MAX_OVERSAMPLE]; + int safe_w = w - kernel_width; + int j; + STBTT_memset(buffer, 0, STBTT_MAX_OVERSAMPLE); // suppress bogus warning from VS2013 -analyze + for (j=0; j < h; ++j) { + int i; + unsigned int total; + STBTT_memset(buffer, 0, kernel_width); + + total = 0; + + // make kernel_width a constant in common cases so compiler can optimize out the divide + switch (kernel_width) { + case 2: + for (i=0; i <= safe_w; ++i) { + total += pixels[i] - buffer[i & STBTT__OVER_MASK]; + buffer[(i+kernel_width) & STBTT__OVER_MASK] = pixels[i]; + pixels[i] = (unsigned char) (total / 2); + } + break; + case 3: + for (i=0; i <= safe_w; ++i) { + total += pixels[i] - buffer[i & STBTT__OVER_MASK]; + buffer[(i+kernel_width) & STBTT__OVER_MASK] = pixels[i]; + pixels[i] = (unsigned char) (total / 3); + } + break; + case 4: + for (i=0; i <= safe_w; ++i) { + total += pixels[i] - buffer[i & STBTT__OVER_MASK]; + buffer[(i+kernel_width) & STBTT__OVER_MASK] = pixels[i]; + pixels[i] = (unsigned char) (total / 4); + } + break; + case 5: + for (i=0; i <= safe_w; ++i) { + total += pixels[i] - buffer[i & STBTT__OVER_MASK]; + buffer[(i+kernel_width) & STBTT__OVER_MASK] = pixels[i]; + pixels[i] = (unsigned char) (total / 5); + } + break; + default: + for (i=0; i <= safe_w; ++i) { + total += pixels[i] - buffer[i & STBTT__OVER_MASK]; + buffer[(i+kernel_width) & STBTT__OVER_MASK] = pixels[i]; + pixels[i] = (unsigned char) (total / kernel_width); + } + break; + } + + for (; i < w; ++i) { + STBTT_assert(pixels[i] == 0); + total -= buffer[i & STBTT__OVER_MASK]; + pixels[i] = (unsigned char) (total / kernel_width); + } + + pixels += stride_in_bytes; + } +} + +static void stbtt__v_prefilter(unsigned char *pixels, int w, int h, int stride_in_bytes, unsigned int kernel_width) +{ + unsigned char buffer[STBTT_MAX_OVERSAMPLE]; + int safe_h = h - kernel_width; + int j; + STBTT_memset(buffer, 0, STBTT_MAX_OVERSAMPLE); // suppress bogus warning from VS2013 -analyze + for (j=0; j < w; ++j) { + int i; + unsigned int total; + STBTT_memset(buffer, 0, kernel_width); + + total = 0; + + // make kernel_width a constant in common cases so compiler can optimize out the divide + switch (kernel_width) { + case 2: + for (i=0; i <= safe_h; ++i) { + total += pixels[i*stride_in_bytes] - buffer[i & STBTT__OVER_MASK]; + buffer[(i+kernel_width) & STBTT__OVER_MASK] = pixels[i*stride_in_bytes]; + pixels[i*stride_in_bytes] = (unsigned char) (total / 2); + } + break; + case 3: + for (i=0; i <= safe_h; ++i) { + total += pixels[i*stride_in_bytes] - buffer[i & STBTT__OVER_MASK]; + buffer[(i+kernel_width) & STBTT__OVER_MASK] = pixels[i*stride_in_bytes]; + pixels[i*stride_in_bytes] = (unsigned char) (total / 3); + } + break; + case 4: + for (i=0; i <= safe_h; ++i) { + total += pixels[i*stride_in_bytes] - buffer[i & STBTT__OVER_MASK]; + buffer[(i+kernel_width) & STBTT__OVER_MASK] = pixels[i*stride_in_bytes]; + pixels[i*stride_in_bytes] = (unsigned char) (total / 4); + } + break; + case 5: + for (i=0; i <= safe_h; ++i) { + total += pixels[i*stride_in_bytes] - buffer[i & STBTT__OVER_MASK]; + buffer[(i+kernel_width) & STBTT__OVER_MASK] = pixels[i*stride_in_bytes]; + pixels[i*stride_in_bytes] = (unsigned char) (total / 5); + } + break; + default: + for (i=0; i <= safe_h; ++i) { + total += pixels[i*stride_in_bytes] - buffer[i & STBTT__OVER_MASK]; + buffer[(i+kernel_width) & STBTT__OVER_MASK] = pixels[i*stride_in_bytes]; + pixels[i*stride_in_bytes] = (unsigned char) (total / kernel_width); + } + break; + } + + for (; i < h; ++i) { + STBTT_assert(pixels[i*stride_in_bytes] == 0); + total -= buffer[i & STBTT__OVER_MASK]; + pixels[i*stride_in_bytes] = (unsigned char) (total / kernel_width); + } + + pixels += 1; + } +} + +static float stbtt__oversample_shift(int oversample) +{ + if (!oversample) + return 0.0f; + + // The prefilter is a box filter of width "oversample", + // which shifts phase by (oversample - 1)/2 pixels in + // oversampled space. We want to shift in the opposite + // direction to counter this. + return (float)-(oversample - 1) / (2.0f * (float)oversample); +} + +// rects array must be big enough to accommodate all characters in the given ranges +STBTT_DEF int stbtt_PackFontRangesGatherRects(stbtt_pack_context *spc, const stbtt_fontinfo *info, stbtt_pack_range *ranges, int num_ranges, stbrp_rect *rects) +{ + int i,j,k; + + k=0; + for (i=0; i < num_ranges; ++i) { + float fh = ranges[i].font_size; + float scale = fh > 0 ? stbtt_ScaleForPixelHeight(info, fh) : stbtt_ScaleForMappingEmToPixels(info, -fh); + ranges[i].h_oversample = (unsigned char) spc->h_oversample; + ranges[i].v_oversample = (unsigned char) spc->v_oversample; + for (j=0; j < ranges[i].num_chars; ++j) { + int x0,y0,x1,y1; + int codepoint = ranges[i].array_of_unicode_codepoints == NULL ? ranges[i].first_unicode_codepoint_in_range + j : ranges[i].array_of_unicode_codepoints[j]; + int glyph = stbtt_FindGlyphIndex(info, codepoint); + if (glyph == 0 && spc->skip_missing) { + rects[k].w = rects[k].h = 0; + } else { + stbtt_GetGlyphBitmapBoxSubpixel(info,glyph, + scale * spc->h_oversample, + scale * spc->v_oversample, + 0,0, + &x0,&y0,&x1,&y1); + rects[k].w = (stbrp_coord) (x1-x0 + spc->padding + spc->h_oversample-1); + rects[k].h = (stbrp_coord) (y1-y0 + spc->padding + spc->v_oversample-1); + } + ++k; + } + } + + return k; +} + +STBTT_DEF void stbtt_MakeGlyphBitmapSubpixelPrefilter(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, unsigned char *output, int out_w, int out_h, int out_stride, float scale_x, float scale_y, float shift_x, float shift_y, int prefilter_x, int prefilter_y, float *sub_x, float *sub_y, int glyph) +{ + stbtt_MakeGlyphBitmapSubpixel(info, + output, + out_w - (prefilter_x - 1), + out_h - (prefilter_y - 1), + out_stride, + scale_x, + scale_y, + shift_x, + shift_y, + glyph); + + if (prefilter_x > 1) + stbtt__h_prefilter(output, out_w, out_h, out_stride, prefilter_x); + + if (prefilter_y > 1) + stbtt__v_prefilter(output, out_w, out_h, out_stride, prefilter_y); + + *sub_x = stbtt__oversample_shift(prefilter_x); + *sub_y = stbtt__oversample_shift(prefilter_y); +} + +// rects array must be big enough to accommodate all characters in the given ranges +STBTT_DEF int stbtt_PackFontRangesRenderIntoRects(stbtt_pack_context *spc, const stbtt_fontinfo *info, stbtt_pack_range *ranges, int num_ranges, stbrp_rect *rects) +{ + int i,j,k, return_value = 1; + + // save current values + int old_h_over = spc->h_oversample; + int old_v_over = spc->v_oversample; + + k = 0; + for (i=0; i < num_ranges; ++i) { + float fh = ranges[i].font_size; + float scale = fh > 0 ? stbtt_ScaleForPixelHeight(info, fh) : stbtt_ScaleForMappingEmToPixels(info, -fh); + float recip_h,recip_v,sub_x,sub_y; + spc->h_oversample = ranges[i].h_oversample; + spc->v_oversample = ranges[i].v_oversample; + recip_h = 1.0f / spc->h_oversample; + recip_v = 1.0f / spc->v_oversample; + sub_x = stbtt__oversample_shift(spc->h_oversample); + sub_y = stbtt__oversample_shift(spc->v_oversample); + for (j=0; j < ranges[i].num_chars; ++j) { + stbrp_rect *r = &rects[k]; + if (r->was_packed && r->w != 0 && r->h != 0) { + stbtt_packedchar *bc = &ranges[i].chardata_for_range[j]; + int advance, lsb, x0,y0,x1,y1; + int codepoint = ranges[i].array_of_unicode_codepoints == NULL ? ranges[i].first_unicode_codepoint_in_range + j : ranges[i].array_of_unicode_codepoints[j]; + int glyph = stbtt_FindGlyphIndex(info, codepoint); + stbrp_coord pad = (stbrp_coord) spc->padding; + + // pad on left and top + r->x += pad; + r->y += pad; + r->w -= pad; + r->h -= pad; + stbtt_GetGlyphHMetrics(info, glyph, &advance, &lsb); + stbtt_GetGlyphBitmapBox(info, glyph, + scale * spc->h_oversample, + scale * spc->v_oversample, + &x0,&y0,&x1,&y1); + stbtt_MakeGlyphBitmapSubpixel(info, + spc->pixels + r->x + r->y*spc->stride_in_bytes, + r->w - spc->h_oversample+1, + r->h - spc->v_oversample+1, + spc->stride_in_bytes, + scale * spc->h_oversample, + scale * spc->v_oversample, + 0,0, + glyph); + + if (spc->h_oversample > 1) + stbtt__h_prefilter(spc->pixels + r->x + r->y*spc->stride_in_bytes, + r->w, r->h, spc->stride_in_bytes, + spc->h_oversample); + + if (spc->v_oversample > 1) + stbtt__v_prefilter(spc->pixels + r->x + r->y*spc->stride_in_bytes, + r->w, r->h, spc->stride_in_bytes, + spc->v_oversample); + + bc->x0 = (stbtt_int16) r->x; + bc->y0 = (stbtt_int16) r->y; + bc->x1 = (stbtt_int16) (r->x + r->w); + bc->y1 = (stbtt_int16) (r->y + r->h); + bc->xadvance = scale * advance; + bc->xoff = (float) x0 * recip_h + sub_x; + bc->yoff = (float) y0 * recip_v + sub_y; + bc->xoff2 = (x0 + r->w) * recip_h + sub_x; + bc->yoff2 = (y0 + r->h) * recip_v + sub_y; + } else { + return_value = 0; // if any fail, report failure + } + + ++k; + } + } + + // restore original values + spc->h_oversample = old_h_over; + spc->v_oversample = old_v_over; + + return return_value; +} + +STBTT_DEF void stbtt_PackFontRangesPackRects(stbtt_pack_context *spc, stbrp_rect *rects, int num_rects) +{ + stbrp_pack_rects((stbrp_context *) spc->pack_info, rects, num_rects); +} + +STBTT_DEF int stbtt_PackFontRanges(stbtt_pack_context *spc, const unsigned char *fontdata, int font_index, stbtt_pack_range *ranges, int num_ranges) +{ + stbtt_fontinfo info; + int i,j,n, return_value; // [DEAR IMGUI] removed = 1 + //stbrp_context *context = (stbrp_context *) spc->pack_info; + stbrp_rect *rects; + + // flag all characters as NOT packed + for (i=0; i < num_ranges; ++i) + for (j=0; j < ranges[i].num_chars; ++j) + ranges[i].chardata_for_range[j].x0 = + ranges[i].chardata_for_range[j].y0 = + ranges[i].chardata_for_range[j].x1 = + ranges[i].chardata_for_range[j].y1 = 0; + + n = 0; + for (i=0; i < num_ranges; ++i) + n += ranges[i].num_chars; + + rects = (stbrp_rect *) STBTT_malloc(sizeof(*rects) * n, spc->user_allocator_context); + if (rects == NULL) + return 0; + + info.userdata = spc->user_allocator_context; + stbtt_InitFont(&info, fontdata, stbtt_GetFontOffsetForIndex(fontdata,font_index)); + + n = stbtt_PackFontRangesGatherRects(spc, &info, ranges, num_ranges, rects); + + stbtt_PackFontRangesPackRects(spc, rects, n); + + return_value = stbtt_PackFontRangesRenderIntoRects(spc, &info, ranges, num_ranges, rects); + + STBTT_free(rects, spc->user_allocator_context); + return return_value; +} + +STBTT_DEF int stbtt_PackFontRange(stbtt_pack_context *spc, const unsigned char *fontdata, int font_index, float font_size, + int first_unicode_codepoint_in_range, int num_chars_in_range, stbtt_packedchar *chardata_for_range) +{ + stbtt_pack_range range; + range.first_unicode_codepoint_in_range = first_unicode_codepoint_in_range; + range.array_of_unicode_codepoints = NULL; + range.num_chars = num_chars_in_range; + range.chardata_for_range = chardata_for_range; + range.font_size = font_size; + return stbtt_PackFontRanges(spc, fontdata, font_index, &range, 1); +} + +STBTT_DEF void stbtt_GetScaledFontVMetrics(const unsigned char *fontdata, int index, float size, float *ascent, float *descent, float *lineGap) +{ + int i_ascent, i_descent, i_lineGap; + float scale; + stbtt_fontinfo info; + stbtt_InitFont(&info, fontdata, stbtt_GetFontOffsetForIndex(fontdata, index)); + scale = size > 0 ? stbtt_ScaleForPixelHeight(&info, size) : stbtt_ScaleForMappingEmToPixels(&info, -size); + stbtt_GetFontVMetrics(&info, &i_ascent, &i_descent, &i_lineGap); + *ascent = (float) i_ascent * scale; + *descent = (float) i_descent * scale; + *lineGap = (float) i_lineGap * scale; +} + +STBTT_DEF void stbtt_GetPackedQuad(const stbtt_packedchar *chardata, int pw, int ph, int char_index, float *xpos, float *ypos, stbtt_aligned_quad *q, int align_to_integer) +{ + float ipw = 1.0f / pw, iph = 1.0f / ph; + const stbtt_packedchar *b = chardata + char_index; + + if (align_to_integer) { + float x = (float) STBTT_ifloor((*xpos + b->xoff) + 0.5f); + float y = (float) STBTT_ifloor((*ypos + b->yoff) + 0.5f); + q->x0 = x; + q->y0 = y; + q->x1 = x + b->xoff2 - b->xoff; + q->y1 = y + b->yoff2 - b->yoff; + } else { + q->x0 = *xpos + b->xoff; + q->y0 = *ypos + b->yoff; + q->x1 = *xpos + b->xoff2; + q->y1 = *ypos + b->yoff2; + } + + q->s0 = b->x0 * ipw; + q->t0 = b->y0 * iph; + q->s1 = b->x1 * ipw; + q->t1 = b->y1 * iph; + + *xpos += b->xadvance; +} + +////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +// +// sdf computation +// + +#define STBTT_min(a,b) ((a) < (b) ? (a) : (b)) +#define STBTT_max(a,b) ((a) < (b) ? (b) : (a)) + +static int stbtt__ray_intersect_bezier(float orig[2], float ray[2], float q0[2], float q1[2], float q2[2], float hits[2][2]) +{ + float q0perp = q0[1]*ray[0] - q0[0]*ray[1]; + float q1perp = q1[1]*ray[0] - q1[0]*ray[1]; + float q2perp = q2[1]*ray[0] - q2[0]*ray[1]; + float roperp = orig[1]*ray[0] - orig[0]*ray[1]; + + float a = q0perp - 2*q1perp + q2perp; + float b = q1perp - q0perp; + float c = q0perp - roperp; + + float s0 = 0., s1 = 0.; + int num_s = 0; + + if (a != 0.0) { + float discr = b*b - a*c; + if (discr > 0.0) { + float rcpna = -1 / a; + float d = (float) STBTT_sqrt(discr); + s0 = (b+d) * rcpna; + s1 = (b-d) * rcpna; + if (s0 >= 0.0 && s0 <= 1.0) + num_s = 1; + if (d > 0.0 && s1 >= 0.0 && s1 <= 1.0) { + if (num_s == 0) s0 = s1; + ++num_s; + } + } + } else { + // 2*b*s + c = 0 + // s = -c / (2*b) + s0 = c / (-2 * b); + if (s0 >= 0.0 && s0 <= 1.0) + num_s = 1; + } + + if (num_s == 0) + return 0; + else { + float rcp_len2 = 1 / (ray[0]*ray[0] + ray[1]*ray[1]); + float rayn_x = ray[0] * rcp_len2, rayn_y = ray[1] * rcp_len2; + + float q0d = q0[0]*rayn_x + q0[1]*rayn_y; + float q1d = q1[0]*rayn_x + q1[1]*rayn_y; + float q2d = q2[0]*rayn_x + q2[1]*rayn_y; + float rod = orig[0]*rayn_x + orig[1]*rayn_y; + + float q10d = q1d - q0d; + float q20d = q2d - q0d; + float q0rd = q0d - rod; + + hits[0][0] = q0rd + s0*(2.0f - 2.0f*s0)*q10d + s0*s0*q20d; + hits[0][1] = a*s0+b; + + if (num_s > 1) { + hits[1][0] = q0rd + s1*(2.0f - 2.0f*s1)*q10d + s1*s1*q20d; + hits[1][1] = a*s1+b; + return 2; + } else { + return 1; + } + } +} + +static int equal(float *a, float *b) +{ + return (a[0] == b[0] && a[1] == b[1]); +} + +static int stbtt__compute_crossings_x(float x, float y, int nverts, stbtt_vertex *verts) +{ + int i; + float orig[2], ray[2] = { 1, 0 }; + float y_frac; + int winding = 0; + + orig[0] = x; + //orig[1] = y; // [DEAR IMGUI] commented double assignment + + // make sure y never passes through a vertex of the shape + y_frac = (float) STBTT_fmod(y, 1.0f); + if (y_frac < 0.01f) + y += 0.01f; + else if (y_frac > 0.99f) + y -= 0.01f; + orig[1] = y; + + // test a ray from (-infinity,y) to (x,y) + for (i=0; i < nverts; ++i) { + if (verts[i].type == STBTT_vline) { + int x0 = (int) verts[i-1].x, y0 = (int) verts[i-1].y; + int x1 = (int) verts[i ].x, y1 = (int) verts[i ].y; + if (y > STBTT_min(y0,y1) && y < STBTT_max(y0,y1) && x > STBTT_min(x0,x1)) { + float x_inter = (y - y0) / (y1 - y0) * (x1-x0) + x0; + if (x_inter < x) + winding += (y0 < y1) ? 1 : -1; + } + } + if (verts[i].type == STBTT_vcurve) { + int x0 = (int) verts[i-1].x , y0 = (int) verts[i-1].y ; + int x1 = (int) verts[i ].cx, y1 = (int) verts[i ].cy; + int x2 = (int) verts[i ].x , y2 = (int) verts[i ].y ; + int ax = STBTT_min(x0,STBTT_min(x1,x2)), ay = STBTT_min(y0,STBTT_min(y1,y2)); + int by = STBTT_max(y0,STBTT_max(y1,y2)); + if (y > ay && y < by && x > ax) { + float q0[2],q1[2],q2[2]; + float hits[2][2]; + q0[0] = (float)x0; + q0[1] = (float)y0; + q1[0] = (float)x1; + q1[1] = (float)y1; + q2[0] = (float)x2; + q2[1] = (float)y2; + if (equal(q0,q1) || equal(q1,q2)) { + x0 = (int)verts[i-1].x; + y0 = (int)verts[i-1].y; + x1 = (int)verts[i ].x; + y1 = (int)verts[i ].y; + if (y > STBTT_min(y0,y1) && y < STBTT_max(y0,y1) && x > STBTT_min(x0,x1)) { + float x_inter = (y - y0) / (y1 - y0) * (x1-x0) + x0; + if (x_inter < x) + winding += (y0 < y1) ? 1 : -1; + } + } else { + int num_hits = stbtt__ray_intersect_bezier(orig, ray, q0, q1, q2, hits); + if (num_hits >= 1) + if (hits[0][0] < 0) + winding += (hits[0][1] < 0 ? -1 : 1); + if (num_hits >= 2) + if (hits[1][0] < 0) + winding += (hits[1][1] < 0 ? -1 : 1); + } + } + } + } + return winding; +} + +static float stbtt__cuberoot( float x ) +{ + if (x<0) + return -(float) STBTT_pow(-x,1.0f/3.0f); + else + return (float) STBTT_pow( x,1.0f/3.0f); +} + +// x^3 + c*x^2 + b*x + a = 0 +static int stbtt__solve_cubic(float a, float b, float c, float* r) +{ + float s = -a / 3; + float p = b - a*a / 3; + float q = a * (2*a*a - 9*b) / 27 + c; + float p3 = p*p*p; + float d = q*q + 4*p3 / 27; + if (d >= 0) { + float z = (float) STBTT_sqrt(d); + float u = (-q + z) / 2; + float v = (-q - z) / 2; + u = stbtt__cuberoot(u); + v = stbtt__cuberoot(v); + r[0] = s + u + v; + return 1; + } else { + float u = (float) STBTT_sqrt(-p/3); + float v = (float) STBTT_acos(-STBTT_sqrt(-27/p3) * q / 2) / 3; // p3 must be negative, since d is negative + float m = (float) STBTT_cos(v); + float n = (float) STBTT_cos(v-3.141592/2)*1.732050808f; + r[0] = s + u * 2 * m; + r[1] = s - u * (m + n); + r[2] = s - u * (m - n); + + //STBTT_assert( STBTT_fabs(((r[0]+a)*r[0]+b)*r[0]+c) < 0.05f); // these asserts may not be safe at all scales, though they're in bezier t parameter units so maybe? + //STBTT_assert( STBTT_fabs(((r[1]+a)*r[1]+b)*r[1]+c) < 0.05f); + //STBTT_assert( STBTT_fabs(((r[2]+a)*r[2]+b)*r[2]+c) < 0.05f); + return 3; + } +} + +STBTT_DEF unsigned char * stbtt_GetGlyphSDF(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, float scale, int glyph, int padding, unsigned char onedge_value, float pixel_dist_scale, int *width, int *height, int *xoff, int *yoff) +{ + float scale_x = scale, scale_y = scale; + int ix0,iy0,ix1,iy1; + int w,h; + unsigned char *data; + + // if one scale is 0, use same scale for both + if (scale_x == 0) scale_x = scale_y; + if (scale_y == 0) { + if (scale_x == 0) return NULL; // if both scales are 0, return NULL + scale_y = scale_x; + } + + stbtt_GetGlyphBitmapBoxSubpixel(info, glyph, scale, scale, 0.0f,0.0f, &ix0,&iy0,&ix1,&iy1); + + // if empty, return NULL + if (ix0 == ix1 || iy0 == iy1) + return NULL; + + ix0 -= padding; + iy0 -= padding; + ix1 += padding; + iy1 += padding; + + w = (ix1 - ix0); + h = (iy1 - iy0); + + if (width ) *width = w; + if (height) *height = h; + if (xoff ) *xoff = ix0; + if (yoff ) *yoff = iy0; + + // invert for y-downwards bitmaps + scale_y = -scale_y; + + { + int x,y,i,j; + float *precompute; + stbtt_vertex *verts; + int num_verts = stbtt_GetGlyphShape(info, glyph, &verts); + data = (unsigned char *) STBTT_malloc(w * h, info->userdata); + precompute = (float *) STBTT_malloc(num_verts * sizeof(float), info->userdata); + + for (i=0,j=num_verts-1; i < num_verts; j=i++) { + if (verts[i].type == STBTT_vline) { + float x0 = verts[i].x*scale_x, y0 = verts[i].y*scale_y; + float x1 = verts[j].x*scale_x, y1 = verts[j].y*scale_y; + float dist = (float) STBTT_sqrt((x1-x0)*(x1-x0) + (y1-y0)*(y1-y0)); + precompute[i] = (dist == 0) ? 0.0f : 1.0f / dist; + } else if (verts[i].type == STBTT_vcurve) { + float x2 = verts[j].x *scale_x, y2 = verts[j].y *scale_y; + float x1 = verts[i].cx*scale_x, y1 = verts[i].cy*scale_y; + float x0 = verts[i].x *scale_x, y0 = verts[i].y *scale_y; + float bx = x0 - 2*x1 + x2, by = y0 - 2*y1 + y2; + float len2 = bx*bx + by*by; + if (len2 != 0.0f) + precompute[i] = 1.0f / (bx*bx + by*by); + else + precompute[i] = 0.0f; + } else + precompute[i] = 0.0f; + } + + for (y=iy0; y < iy1; ++y) { + for (x=ix0; x < ix1; ++x) { + float val; + float min_dist = 999999.0f; + float sx = (float) x + 0.5f; + float sy = (float) y + 0.5f; + float x_gspace = (sx / scale_x); + float y_gspace = (sy / scale_y); + + int winding = stbtt__compute_crossings_x(x_gspace, y_gspace, num_verts, verts); // @OPTIMIZE: this could just be a rasterization, but needs to be line vs. non-tesselated curves so a new path + + for (i=0; i < num_verts; ++i) { + float x0 = verts[i].x*scale_x, y0 = verts[i].y*scale_y; + + // check against every point here rather than inside line/curve primitives -- @TODO: wrong if multiple 'moves' in a row produce a garbage point, and given culling, probably more efficient to do within line/curve + float dist2 = (x0-sx)*(x0-sx) + (y0-sy)*(y0-sy); + if (dist2 < min_dist*min_dist) + min_dist = (float) STBTT_sqrt(dist2); + + if (verts[i].type == STBTT_vline) { + float x1 = verts[i-1].x*scale_x, y1 = verts[i-1].y*scale_y; + + // coarse culling against bbox + //if (sx > STBTT_min(x0,x1)-min_dist && sx < STBTT_max(x0,x1)+min_dist && + // sy > STBTT_min(y0,y1)-min_dist && sy < STBTT_max(y0,y1)+min_dist) + float dist = (float) STBTT_fabs((x1-x0)*(y0-sy) - (y1-y0)*(x0-sx)) * precompute[i]; + STBTT_assert(i != 0); + if (dist < min_dist) { + // check position along line + // x' = x0 + t*(x1-x0), y' = y0 + t*(y1-y0) + // minimize (x'-sx)*(x'-sx)+(y'-sy)*(y'-sy) + float dx = x1-x0, dy = y1-y0; + float px = x0-sx, py = y0-sy; + // minimize (px+t*dx)^2 + (py+t*dy)^2 = px*px + 2*px*dx*t + t^2*dx*dx + py*py + 2*py*dy*t + t^2*dy*dy + // derivative: 2*px*dx + 2*py*dy + (2*dx*dx+2*dy*dy)*t, set to 0 and solve + float t = -(px*dx + py*dy) / (dx*dx + dy*dy); + if (t >= 0.0f && t <= 1.0f) + min_dist = dist; + } + } else if (verts[i].type == STBTT_vcurve) { + float x2 = verts[i-1].x *scale_x, y2 = verts[i-1].y *scale_y; + float x1 = verts[i ].cx*scale_x, y1 = verts[i ].cy*scale_y; + float box_x0 = STBTT_min(STBTT_min(x0,x1),x2); + float box_y0 = STBTT_min(STBTT_min(y0,y1),y2); + float box_x1 = STBTT_max(STBTT_max(x0,x1),x2); + float box_y1 = STBTT_max(STBTT_max(y0,y1),y2); + // coarse culling against bbox to avoid computing cubic unnecessarily + if (sx > box_x0-min_dist && sx < box_x1+min_dist && sy > box_y0-min_dist && sy < box_y1+min_dist) { + int num=0; + float ax = x1-x0, ay = y1-y0; + float bx = x0 - 2*x1 + x2, by = y0 - 2*y1 + y2; + float mx = x0 - sx, my = y0 - sy; + float res[3],px,py,t,it; + float a_inv = precompute[i]; + if (a_inv == 0.0) { // if a_inv is 0, it's 2nd degree so use quadratic formula + float a = 3*(ax*bx + ay*by); + float b = 2*(ax*ax + ay*ay) + (mx*bx+my*by); + float c = mx*ax+my*ay; + if (a == 0.0) { // if a is 0, it's linear + if (b != 0.0) { + res[num++] = -c/b; + } + } else { + float discriminant = b*b - 4*a*c; + if (discriminant < 0) + num = 0; + else { + float root = (float) STBTT_sqrt(discriminant); + res[0] = (-b - root)/(2*a); + res[1] = (-b + root)/(2*a); + num = 2; // don't bother distinguishing 1-solution case, as code below will still work + } + } + } else { + float b = 3*(ax*bx + ay*by) * a_inv; // could precompute this as it doesn't depend on sample point + float c = (2*(ax*ax + ay*ay) + (mx*bx+my*by)) * a_inv; + float d = (mx*ax+my*ay) * a_inv; + num = stbtt__solve_cubic(b, c, d, res); + } + if (num >= 1 && res[0] >= 0.0f && res[0] <= 1.0f) { + t = res[0], it = 1.0f - t; + px = it*it*x0 + 2*t*it*x1 + t*t*x2; + py = it*it*y0 + 2*t*it*y1 + t*t*y2; + dist2 = (px-sx)*(px-sx) + (py-sy)*(py-sy); + if (dist2 < min_dist * min_dist) + min_dist = (float) STBTT_sqrt(dist2); + } + if (num >= 2 && res[1] >= 0.0f && res[1] <= 1.0f) { + t = res[1], it = 1.0f - t; + px = it*it*x0 + 2*t*it*x1 + t*t*x2; + py = it*it*y0 + 2*t*it*y1 + t*t*y2; + dist2 = (px-sx)*(px-sx) + (py-sy)*(py-sy); + if (dist2 < min_dist * min_dist) + min_dist = (float) STBTT_sqrt(dist2); + } + if (num >= 3 && res[2] >= 0.0f && res[2] <= 1.0f) { + t = res[2], it = 1.0f - t; + px = it*it*x0 + 2*t*it*x1 + t*t*x2; + py = it*it*y0 + 2*t*it*y1 + t*t*y2; + dist2 = (px-sx)*(px-sx) + (py-sy)*(py-sy); + if (dist2 < min_dist * min_dist) + min_dist = (float) STBTT_sqrt(dist2); + } + } + } + } + if (winding == 0) + min_dist = -min_dist; // if outside the shape, value is negative + val = onedge_value + pixel_dist_scale * min_dist; + if (val < 0) + val = 0; + else if (val > 255) + val = 255; + data[(y-iy0)*w+(x-ix0)] = (unsigned char) val; + } + } + STBTT_free(precompute, info->userdata); + STBTT_free(verts, info->userdata); + } + return data; +} + +STBTT_DEF unsigned char * stbtt_GetCodepointSDF(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, float scale, int codepoint, int padding, unsigned char onedge_value, float pixel_dist_scale, int *width, int *height, int *xoff, int *yoff) +{ + return stbtt_GetGlyphSDF(info, scale, stbtt_FindGlyphIndex(info, codepoint), padding, onedge_value, pixel_dist_scale, width, height, xoff, yoff); +} + +STBTT_DEF void stbtt_FreeSDF(unsigned char *bitmap, void *userdata) +{ + STBTT_free(bitmap, userdata); +} + +////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +// +// font name matching -- recommended not to use this +// + +// check if a utf8 string contains a prefix which is the utf16 string; if so return length of matching utf8 string +static stbtt_int32 stbtt__CompareUTF8toUTF16_bigendian_prefix(stbtt_uint8 *s1, stbtt_int32 len1, stbtt_uint8 *s2, stbtt_int32 len2) +{ + stbtt_int32 i=0; + + // convert utf16 to utf8 and compare the results while converting + while (len2) { + stbtt_uint16 ch = s2[0]*256 + s2[1]; + if (ch < 0x80) { + if (i >= len1) return -1; + if (s1[i++] != ch) return -1; + } else if (ch < 0x800) { + if (i+1 >= len1) return -1; + if (s1[i++] != 0xc0 + (ch >> 6)) return -1; + if (s1[i++] != 0x80 + (ch & 0x3f)) return -1; + } else if (ch >= 0xd800 && ch < 0xdc00) { + stbtt_uint32 c; + stbtt_uint16 ch2 = s2[2]*256 + s2[3]; + if (i+3 >= len1) return -1; + c = ((ch - 0xd800) << 10) + (ch2 - 0xdc00) + 0x10000; + if (s1[i++] != 0xf0 + (c >> 18)) return -1; + if (s1[i++] != 0x80 + ((c >> 12) & 0x3f)) return -1; + if (s1[i++] != 0x80 + ((c >> 6) & 0x3f)) return -1; + if (s1[i++] != 0x80 + ((c ) & 0x3f)) return -1; + s2 += 2; // plus another 2 below + len2 -= 2; + } else if (ch >= 0xdc00 && ch < 0xe000) { + return -1; + } else { + if (i+2 >= len1) return -1; + if (s1[i++] != 0xe0 + (ch >> 12)) return -1; + if (s1[i++] != 0x80 + ((ch >> 6) & 0x3f)) return -1; + if (s1[i++] != 0x80 + ((ch ) & 0x3f)) return -1; + } + s2 += 2; + len2 -= 2; + } + return i; +} + +static int stbtt_CompareUTF8toUTF16_bigendian_internal(char *s1, int len1, char *s2, int len2) +{ + return len1 == stbtt__CompareUTF8toUTF16_bigendian_prefix((stbtt_uint8*) s1, len1, (stbtt_uint8*) s2, len2); +} + +// returns results in whatever encoding you request... but note that 2-byte encodings +// will be BIG-ENDIAN... use stbtt_CompareUTF8toUTF16_bigendian() to compare +STBTT_DEF const char *stbtt_GetFontNameString(const stbtt_fontinfo *font, int *length, int platformID, int encodingID, int languageID, int nameID) +{ + stbtt_int32 i,count,stringOffset; + stbtt_uint8 *fc = font->data; + stbtt_uint32 offset = font->fontstart; + stbtt_uint32 nm = stbtt__find_table(fc, offset, "name"); + if (!nm) return NULL; + + count = ttUSHORT(fc+nm+2); + stringOffset = nm + ttUSHORT(fc+nm+4); + for (i=0; i < count; ++i) { + stbtt_uint32 loc = nm + 6 + 12 * i; + if (platformID == ttUSHORT(fc+loc+0) && encodingID == ttUSHORT(fc+loc+2) + && languageID == ttUSHORT(fc+loc+4) && nameID == ttUSHORT(fc+loc+6)) { + *length = ttUSHORT(fc+loc+8); + return (const char *) (fc+stringOffset+ttUSHORT(fc+loc+10)); + } + } + return NULL; +} + +static int stbtt__matchpair(stbtt_uint8 *fc, stbtt_uint32 nm, stbtt_uint8 *name, stbtt_int32 nlen, stbtt_int32 target_id, stbtt_int32 next_id) +{ + stbtt_int32 i; + stbtt_int32 count = ttUSHORT(fc+nm+2); + stbtt_int32 stringOffset = nm + ttUSHORT(fc+nm+4); + + for (i=0; i < count; ++i) { + stbtt_uint32 loc = nm + 6 + 12 * i; + stbtt_int32 id = ttUSHORT(fc+loc+6); + if (id == target_id) { + // find the encoding + stbtt_int32 platform = ttUSHORT(fc+loc+0), encoding = ttUSHORT(fc+loc+2), language = ttUSHORT(fc+loc+4); + + // is this a Unicode encoding? + if (platform == 0 || (platform == 3 && encoding == 1) || (platform == 3 && encoding == 10)) { + stbtt_int32 slen = ttUSHORT(fc+loc+8); + stbtt_int32 off = ttUSHORT(fc+loc+10); + + // check if there's a prefix match + stbtt_int32 matchlen = stbtt__CompareUTF8toUTF16_bigendian_prefix(name, nlen, fc+stringOffset+off,slen); + if (matchlen >= 0) { + // check for target_id+1 immediately following, with same encoding & language + if (i+1 < count && ttUSHORT(fc+loc+12+6) == next_id && ttUSHORT(fc+loc+12) == platform && ttUSHORT(fc+loc+12+2) == encoding && ttUSHORT(fc+loc+12+4) == language) { + slen = ttUSHORT(fc+loc+12+8); + off = ttUSHORT(fc+loc+12+10); + if (slen == 0) { + if (matchlen == nlen) + return 1; + } else if (matchlen < nlen && name[matchlen] == ' ') { + ++matchlen; + if (stbtt_CompareUTF8toUTF16_bigendian_internal((char*) (name+matchlen), nlen-matchlen, (char*)(fc+stringOffset+off),slen)) + return 1; + } + } else { + // if nothing immediately following + if (matchlen == nlen) + return 1; + } + } + } + + // @TODO handle other encodings + } + } + return 0; +} + +static int stbtt__matches(stbtt_uint8 *fc, stbtt_uint32 offset, stbtt_uint8 *name, stbtt_int32 flags) +{ + stbtt_int32 nlen = (stbtt_int32) STBTT_strlen((char *) name); + stbtt_uint32 nm,hd; + if (!stbtt__isfont(fc+offset)) return 0; + + // check italics/bold/underline flags in macStyle... + if (flags) { + hd = stbtt__find_table(fc, offset, "head"); + if ((ttUSHORT(fc+hd+44) & 7) != (flags & 7)) return 0; + } + + nm = stbtt__find_table(fc, offset, "name"); + if (!nm) return 0; + + if (flags) { + // if we checked the macStyle flags, then just check the family and ignore the subfamily + if (stbtt__matchpair(fc, nm, name, nlen, 16, -1)) return 1; + if (stbtt__matchpair(fc, nm, name, nlen, 1, -1)) return 1; + if (stbtt__matchpair(fc, nm, name, nlen, 3, -1)) return 1; + } else { + if (stbtt__matchpair(fc, nm, name, nlen, 16, 17)) return 1; + if (stbtt__matchpair(fc, nm, name, nlen, 1, 2)) return 1; + if (stbtt__matchpair(fc, nm, name, nlen, 3, -1)) return 1; + } + + return 0; +} + +static int stbtt_FindMatchingFont_internal(unsigned char *font_collection, char *name_utf8, stbtt_int32 flags) +{ + stbtt_int32 i; + for (i=0;;++i) { + stbtt_int32 off = stbtt_GetFontOffsetForIndex(font_collection, i); + if (off < 0) return off; + if (stbtt__matches((stbtt_uint8 *) font_collection, off, (stbtt_uint8*) name_utf8, flags)) + return off; + } +} + +#if defined(__GNUC__) || defined(__clang__) +#pragma GCC diagnostic push +#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wcast-qual" +#endif + +STBTT_DEF int stbtt_BakeFontBitmap(const unsigned char *data, int offset, + float pixel_height, unsigned char *pixels, int pw, int ph, + int first_char, int num_chars, stbtt_bakedchar *chardata) +{ + return stbtt_BakeFontBitmap_internal((unsigned char *) data, offset, pixel_height, pixels, pw, ph, first_char, num_chars, chardata); +} + +STBTT_DEF int stbtt_GetFontOffsetForIndex(const unsigned char *data, int index) +{ + return stbtt_GetFontOffsetForIndex_internal((unsigned char *) data, index); +} + +STBTT_DEF int stbtt_GetNumberOfFonts(const unsigned char *data) +{ + return stbtt_GetNumberOfFonts_internal((unsigned char *) data); +} + +STBTT_DEF int stbtt_InitFont(stbtt_fontinfo *info, const unsigned char *data, int offset) +{ + return stbtt_InitFont_internal(info, (unsigned char *) data, offset); +} + +STBTT_DEF int stbtt_FindMatchingFont(const unsigned char *fontdata, const char *name, int flags) +{ + return stbtt_FindMatchingFont_internal((unsigned char *) fontdata, (char *) name, flags); +} + +STBTT_DEF int stbtt_CompareUTF8toUTF16_bigendian(const char *s1, int len1, const char *s2, int len2) +{ + return stbtt_CompareUTF8toUTF16_bigendian_internal((char *) s1, len1, (char *) s2, len2); +} + +#if defined(__GNUC__) || defined(__clang__) +#pragma GCC diagnostic pop +#endif + +#endif // STB_TRUETYPE_IMPLEMENTATION + + +// FULL VERSION HISTORY +// +// 1.19 (2018-02-11) OpenType GPOS kerning (horizontal only), STBTT_fmod +// 1.18 (2018-01-29) add missing function +// 1.17 (2017-07-23) make more arguments const; doc fix +// 1.16 (2017-07-12) SDF support +// 1.15 (2017-03-03) make more arguments const +// 1.14 (2017-01-16) num-fonts-in-TTC function +// 1.13 (2017-01-02) support OpenType fonts, certain Apple fonts +// 1.12 (2016-10-25) suppress warnings about casting away const with -Wcast-qual +// 1.11 (2016-04-02) fix unused-variable warning +// 1.10 (2016-04-02) allow user-defined fabs() replacement +// fix memory leak if fontsize=0.0 +// fix warning from duplicate typedef +// 1.09 (2016-01-16) warning fix; avoid crash on outofmem; use alloc userdata for PackFontRanges +// 1.08 (2015-09-13) document stbtt_Rasterize(); fixes for vertical & horizontal edges +// 1.07 (2015-08-01) allow PackFontRanges to accept arrays of sparse codepoints; +// allow PackFontRanges to pack and render in separate phases; +// fix stbtt_GetFontOFfsetForIndex (never worked for non-0 input?); +// fixed an assert() bug in the new rasterizer +// replace assert() with STBTT_assert() in new rasterizer +// 1.06 (2015-07-14) performance improvements (~35% faster on x86 and x64 on test machine) +// also more precise AA rasterizer, except if shapes overlap +// remove need for STBTT_sort +// 1.05 (2015-04-15) fix misplaced definitions for STBTT_STATIC +// 1.04 (2015-04-15) typo in example +// 1.03 (2015-04-12) STBTT_STATIC, fix memory leak in new packing, various fixes +// 1.02 (2014-12-10) fix various warnings & compile issues w/ stb_rect_pack, C++ +// 1.01 (2014-12-08) fix subpixel position when oversampling to exactly match +// non-oversampled; STBTT_POINT_SIZE for packed case only +// 1.00 (2014-12-06) add new PackBegin etc. API, w/ support for oversampling +// 0.99 (2014-09-18) fix multiple bugs with subpixel rendering (ryg) +// 0.9 (2014-08-07) support certain mac/iOS fonts without an MS platformID +// 0.8b (2014-07-07) fix a warning +// 0.8 (2014-05-25) fix a few more warnings +// 0.7 (2013-09-25) bugfix: subpixel glyph bug fixed in 0.5 had come back +// 0.6c (2012-07-24) improve documentation +// 0.6b (2012-07-20) fix a few more warnings +// 0.6 (2012-07-17) fix warnings; added stbtt_ScaleForMappingEmToPixels, +// stbtt_GetFontBoundingBox, stbtt_IsGlyphEmpty +// 0.5 (2011-12-09) bugfixes: +// subpixel glyph renderer computed wrong bounding box +// first vertex of shape can be off-curve (FreeSans) +// 0.4b (2011-12-03) fixed an error in the font baking example +// 0.4 (2011-12-01) kerning, subpixel rendering (tor) +// bugfixes for: +// codepoint-to-glyph conversion using table fmt=12 +// codepoint-to-glyph conversion using table fmt=4 +// stbtt_GetBakedQuad with non-square texture (Zer) +// updated Hello World! sample to use kerning and subpixel +// fixed some warnings +// 0.3 (2009-06-24) cmap fmt=12, compound shapes (MM) +// userdata, malloc-from-userdata, non-zero fill (stb) +// 0.2 (2009-03-11) Fix unsigned/signed char warnings +// 0.1 (2009-03-09) First public release +// + +/* +------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +This software is available under 2 licenses -- choose whichever you prefer. +------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +ALTERNATIVE A - MIT License +Copyright (c) 2017 Sean Barrett +Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy of +this software and associated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal in +the Software without restriction, including without limitation the rights to +use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies +of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do +so, subject to the following conditions: +The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in all +copies or substantial portions of the Software. +THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR +IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, +FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE +AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER +LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, +OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE +SOFTWARE. +------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +ALTERNATIVE B - Public Domain (www.unlicense.org) +This is free and unencumbered software released into the public domain. +Anyone is free to copy, modify, publish, use, compile, sell, or distribute this +software, either in source code form or as a compiled binary, for any purpose, +commercial or non-commercial, and by any means. +In jurisdictions that recognize copyright laws, the author or authors of this +software dedicate any and all copyright interest in the software to the public +domain. We make this dedication for the benefit of the public at large and to +the detriment of our heirs and successors. We intend this dedication to be an +overt act of relinquishment in perpetuity of all present and future rights to +this software under copyright law. +THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR +IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, +FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE +AUTHORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN +ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION +WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. +------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +*/ diff --git a/3rdparty/imnodes/example/color_node_editor.cpp b/3rdparty/imnodes/example/color_node_editor.cpp new file mode 100644 index 0000000..d0983a2 --- /dev/null +++ b/3rdparty/imnodes/example/color_node_editor.cpp @@ -0,0 +1,710 @@ +#include "node_editor.h" +#include "graph.h" + +#include +#include + +#include +#include +#include +#include +#include +#include +#include + +namespace example +{ +namespace +{ +enum class NodeType +{ + add, + multiply, + output, + sine, + time, + value +}; + +struct Node +{ + NodeType type; + float value; + + explicit Node(const NodeType t) : type(t), value(0.f) {} + + Node(const NodeType t, const float v) : type(t), value(v) {} +}; + +template +T clamp(T x, T a, T b) +{ + return std::min(b, std::max(x, a)); +} + +static float current_time_seconds = 0.f; +static bool emulate_three_button_mouse = false; + +ImU32 evaluate(const Graph& graph, const int root_node) +{ + std::stack postorder; + dfs_traverse( + graph, root_node, [&postorder](const int node_id) -> void { postorder.push(node_id); }); + + std::stack value_stack; + while (!postorder.empty()) + { + const int id = postorder.top(); + postorder.pop(); + const Node node = graph.node(id); + + switch (node.type) + { + case NodeType::add: + { + const float rhs = value_stack.top(); + value_stack.pop(); + const float lhs = value_stack.top(); + value_stack.pop(); + value_stack.push(lhs + rhs); + } + break; + case NodeType::multiply: + { + const float rhs = value_stack.top(); + value_stack.pop(); + const float lhs = value_stack.top(); + value_stack.pop(); + value_stack.push(rhs * lhs); + } + break; + case NodeType::sine: + { + const float x = value_stack.top(); + value_stack.pop(); + const float res = std::abs(std::sin(x)); + value_stack.push(res); + } + break; + case NodeType::time: + { + value_stack.push(current_time_seconds); + } + break; + case NodeType::value: + { + // If the edge does not have an edge connecting to another node, then just use the value + // at this node. It means the node's input pin has not been connected to anything and + // the value comes from the node's UI. + if (graph.num_edges_from_node(id) == 0ull) + { + value_stack.push(node.value); + } + } + break; + default: + break; + } + } + + // The final output node isn't evaluated in the loop -- instead we just pop + // the three values which should be in the stack. + assert(value_stack.size() == 3ull); + const int b = static_cast(255.f * clamp(value_stack.top(), 0.f, 1.f) + 0.5f); + value_stack.pop(); + const int g = static_cast(255.f * clamp(value_stack.top(), 0.f, 1.f) + 0.5f); + value_stack.pop(); + const int r = static_cast(255.f * clamp(value_stack.top(), 0.f, 1.f) + 0.5f); + value_stack.pop(); + + return IM_COL32(r, g, b, 255); +} + +class ColorNodeEditor +{ +public: + ColorNodeEditor() : graph_(), nodes_(), root_node_id_(-1), + minimap_location_(ImNodesMiniMapLocation_BottomRight) {} + + void show() + { + // Update timer context + current_time_seconds = 0.001f * SDL_GetTicks(); + + auto flags = ImGuiWindowFlags_MenuBar; + + // The node editor window + ImGui::Begin("color node editor", NULL, flags); + + if (ImGui::BeginMenuBar()) + { + if (ImGui::BeginMenu("Mini-map")) + { + const char* names[] = { + "Top Left", + "Top Right", + "Bottom Left", + "Bottom Right", + }; + int locations[] = { + ImNodesMiniMapLocation_TopLeft, + ImNodesMiniMapLocation_TopRight, + ImNodesMiniMapLocation_BottomLeft, + ImNodesMiniMapLocation_BottomRight, + }; + + for (int i = 0; i < 4; i++) + { + bool selected = minimap_location_ == locations[i]; + if (ImGui::MenuItem(names[i], NULL, &selected)) + minimap_location_ = locations[i]; + } + ImGui::EndMenu(); + } + + if (ImGui::BeginMenu("Style")) + { + if (ImGui::MenuItem("Classic")) + { + ImGui::StyleColorsClassic(); + ImNodes::StyleColorsClassic(); + } + if (ImGui::MenuItem("Dark")) + { + ImGui::StyleColorsDark(); + ImNodes::StyleColorsDark(); + } + if (ImGui::MenuItem("Light")) + { + ImGui::StyleColorsLight(); + ImNodes::StyleColorsLight(); + } + ImGui::EndMenu(); + } + + ImGui::EndMenuBar(); + } + + ImGui::TextUnformatted("Edit the color of the output color window using nodes."); + ImGui::Columns(2); + ImGui::TextUnformatted("A -- add node"); + ImGui::TextUnformatted("X -- delete selected node or link"); + ImGui::NextColumn(); + if (ImGui::Checkbox("emulate_three_button_mouse", &emulate_three_button_mouse)) + { + ImNodes::GetIO().EmulateThreeButtonMouse.Modifier = + emulate_three_button_mouse ? &ImGui::GetIO().KeyAlt : NULL; + } + ImGui::Columns(1); + + ImNodes::BeginNodeEditor(); + + // Handle new nodes + // These are driven by the user, so we place this code before rendering the nodes + { + const bool open_popup = ImGui::IsWindowFocused(ImGuiFocusedFlags_RootAndChildWindows) && + ImNodes::IsEditorHovered() && + ImGui::IsKeyReleased(SDL_SCANCODE_A); + + ImGui::PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_WindowPadding, ImVec2(8.f, 8.f)); + if (!ImGui::IsAnyItemHovered() && open_popup) + { + ImGui::OpenPopup("add node"); + } + + if (ImGui::BeginPopup("add node")) + { + const ImVec2 click_pos = ImGui::GetMousePosOnOpeningCurrentPopup(); + + if (ImGui::MenuItem("add")) + { + const Node value(NodeType::value, 0.f); + const Node op(NodeType::add); + + UiNode ui_node; + ui_node.type = UiNodeType::add; + ui_node.add.lhs = graph_.insert_node(value); + ui_node.add.rhs = graph_.insert_node(value); + ui_node.id = graph_.insert_node(op); + + graph_.insert_edge(ui_node.id, ui_node.add.lhs); + graph_.insert_edge(ui_node.id, ui_node.add.rhs); + + nodes_.push_back(ui_node); + ImNodes::SetNodeScreenSpacePos(ui_node.id, click_pos); + } + + if (ImGui::MenuItem("multiply")) + { + const Node value(NodeType::value, 0.f); + const Node op(NodeType::multiply); + + UiNode ui_node; + ui_node.type = UiNodeType::multiply; + ui_node.multiply.lhs = graph_.insert_node(value); + ui_node.multiply.rhs = graph_.insert_node(value); + ui_node.id = graph_.insert_node(op); + + graph_.insert_edge(ui_node.id, ui_node.multiply.lhs); + graph_.insert_edge(ui_node.id, ui_node.multiply.rhs); + + nodes_.push_back(ui_node); + ImNodes::SetNodeScreenSpacePos(ui_node.id, click_pos); + } + + if (ImGui::MenuItem("output") && root_node_id_ == -1) + { + const Node value(NodeType::value, 0.f); + const Node out(NodeType::output); + + UiNode ui_node; + ui_node.type = UiNodeType::output; + ui_node.output.r = graph_.insert_node(value); + ui_node.output.g = graph_.insert_node(value); + ui_node.output.b = graph_.insert_node(value); + ui_node.id = graph_.insert_node(out); + + graph_.insert_edge(ui_node.id, ui_node.output.r); + graph_.insert_edge(ui_node.id, ui_node.output.g); + graph_.insert_edge(ui_node.id, ui_node.output.b); + + nodes_.push_back(ui_node); + ImNodes::SetNodeScreenSpacePos(ui_node.id, click_pos); + root_node_id_ = ui_node.id; + } + + if (ImGui::MenuItem("sine")) + { + const Node value(NodeType::value, 0.f); + const Node op(NodeType::sine); + + UiNode ui_node; + ui_node.type = UiNodeType::sine; + ui_node.sine.input = graph_.insert_node(value); + ui_node.id = graph_.insert_node(op); + + graph_.insert_edge(ui_node.id, ui_node.sine.input); + + nodes_.push_back(ui_node); + ImNodes::SetNodeScreenSpacePos(ui_node.id, click_pos); + } + + if (ImGui::MenuItem("time")) + { + UiNode ui_node; + ui_node.type = UiNodeType::time; + ui_node.id = graph_.insert_node(Node(NodeType::time)); + + nodes_.push_back(ui_node); + ImNodes::SetNodeScreenSpacePos(ui_node.id, click_pos); + } + + ImGui::EndPopup(); + } + ImGui::PopStyleVar(); + } + + for (const UiNode& node : nodes_) + { + switch (node.type) + { + case UiNodeType::add: + { + const float node_width = 100.f; + ImNodes::BeginNode(node.id); + + ImNodes::BeginNodeTitleBar(); + ImGui::TextUnformatted("add"); + ImNodes::EndNodeTitleBar(); + { + ImNodes::BeginInputAttribute(node.add.lhs); + const float label_width = ImGui::CalcTextSize("left").x; + ImGui::TextUnformatted("left"); + if (graph_.num_edges_from_node(node.add.lhs) == 0ull) + { + ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::PushItemWidth(node_width - label_width); + ImGui::DragFloat("##hidelabel", &graph_.node(node.add.lhs).value, 0.01f); + ImGui::PopItemWidth(); + } + ImNodes::EndInputAttribute(); + } + + { + ImNodes::BeginInputAttribute(node.add.rhs); + const float label_width = ImGui::CalcTextSize("right").x; + ImGui::TextUnformatted("right"); + if (graph_.num_edges_from_node(node.add.rhs) == 0ull) + { + ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::PushItemWidth(node_width - label_width); + ImGui::DragFloat("##hidelabel", &graph_.node(node.add.rhs).value, 0.01f); + ImGui::PopItemWidth(); + } + ImNodes::EndInputAttribute(); + } + + ImGui::Spacing(); + + { + ImNodes::BeginOutputAttribute(node.id); + const float label_width = ImGui::CalcTextSize("result").x; + ImGui::Indent(node_width - label_width); + ImGui::TextUnformatted("result"); + ImNodes::EndOutputAttribute(); + } + + ImNodes::EndNode(); + } + break; + case UiNodeType::multiply: + { + const float node_width = 100.0f; + ImNodes::BeginNode(node.id); + + ImNodes::BeginNodeTitleBar(); + ImGui::TextUnformatted("multiply"); + ImNodes::EndNodeTitleBar(); + + { + ImNodes::BeginInputAttribute(node.multiply.lhs); + const float label_width = ImGui::CalcTextSize("left").x; + ImGui::TextUnformatted("left"); + if (graph_.num_edges_from_node(node.multiply.lhs) == 0ull) + { + ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::PushItemWidth(node_width - label_width); + ImGui::DragFloat( + "##hidelabel", &graph_.node(node.multiply.lhs).value, 0.01f); + ImGui::PopItemWidth(); + } + ImNodes::EndInputAttribute(); + } + + { + ImNodes::BeginInputAttribute(node.multiply.rhs); + const float label_width = ImGui::CalcTextSize("right").x; + ImGui::TextUnformatted("right"); + if (graph_.num_edges_from_node(node.multiply.rhs) == 0ull) + { + ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::PushItemWidth(node_width - label_width); + ImGui::DragFloat( + "##hidelabel", &graph_.node(node.multiply.rhs).value, 0.01f); + ImGui::PopItemWidth(); + } + ImNodes::EndInputAttribute(); + } + + ImGui::Spacing(); + + { + ImNodes::BeginOutputAttribute(node.id); + const float label_width = ImGui::CalcTextSize("result").x; + ImGui::Indent(node_width - label_width); + ImGui::TextUnformatted("result"); + ImNodes::EndOutputAttribute(); + } + + ImNodes::EndNode(); + } + break; + case UiNodeType::output: + { + const float node_width = 100.0f; + ImNodes::PushColorStyle(ImNodesCol_TitleBar, IM_COL32(11, 109, 191, 255)); + ImNodes::PushColorStyle(ImNodesCol_TitleBarHovered, IM_COL32(45, 126, 194, 255)); + ImNodes::PushColorStyle(ImNodesCol_TitleBarSelected, IM_COL32(81, 148, 204, 255)); + ImNodes::BeginNode(node.id); + + ImNodes::BeginNodeTitleBar(); + ImGui::TextUnformatted("output"); + ImNodes::EndNodeTitleBar(); + + ImGui::Dummy(ImVec2(node_width, 0.f)); + { + ImNodes::BeginInputAttribute(node.output.r); + const float label_width = ImGui::CalcTextSize("r").x; + ImGui::TextUnformatted("r"); + if (graph_.num_edges_from_node(node.output.r) == 0ull) + { + ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::PushItemWidth(node_width - label_width); + ImGui::DragFloat( + "##hidelabel", &graph_.node(node.output.r).value, 0.01f, 0.f, 1.0f); + ImGui::PopItemWidth(); + } + ImNodes::EndInputAttribute(); + } + + ImGui::Spacing(); + + { + ImNodes::BeginInputAttribute(node.output.g); + const float label_width = ImGui::CalcTextSize("g").x; + ImGui::TextUnformatted("g"); + if (graph_.num_edges_from_node(node.output.g) == 0ull) + { + ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::PushItemWidth(node_width - label_width); + ImGui::DragFloat( + "##hidelabel", &graph_.node(node.output.g).value, 0.01f, 0.f, 1.f); + ImGui::PopItemWidth(); + } + ImNodes::EndInputAttribute(); + } + + ImGui::Spacing(); + + { + ImNodes::BeginInputAttribute(node.output.b); + const float label_width = ImGui::CalcTextSize("b").x; + ImGui::TextUnformatted("b"); + if (graph_.num_edges_from_node(node.output.b) == 0ull) + { + ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::PushItemWidth(node_width - label_width); + ImGui::DragFloat( + "##hidelabel", &graph_.node(node.output.b).value, 0.01f, 0.f, 1.0f); + ImGui::PopItemWidth(); + } + ImNodes::EndInputAttribute(); + } + ImNodes::EndNode(); + ImNodes::PopColorStyle(); + ImNodes::PopColorStyle(); + ImNodes::PopColorStyle(); + } + break; + case UiNodeType::sine: + { + const float node_width = 100.0f; + ImNodes::BeginNode(node.id); + + ImNodes::BeginNodeTitleBar(); + ImGui::TextUnformatted("sine"); + ImNodes::EndNodeTitleBar(); + + { + ImNodes::BeginInputAttribute(node.sine.input); + const float label_width = ImGui::CalcTextSize("number").x; + ImGui::TextUnformatted("number"); + if (graph_.num_edges_from_node(node.sine.input) == 0ull) + { + ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::PushItemWidth(node_width - label_width); + ImGui::DragFloat( + "##hidelabel", &graph_.node(node.sine.input).value, 0.01f, 0.f, 1.0f); + ImGui::PopItemWidth(); + } + ImNodes::EndInputAttribute(); + } + + ImGui::Spacing(); + + { + ImNodes::BeginOutputAttribute(node.id); + const float label_width = ImGui::CalcTextSize("output").x; + ImGui::Indent(node_width - label_width); + ImGui::TextUnformatted("output"); + ImNodes::EndInputAttribute(); + } + + ImNodes::EndNode(); + } + break; + case UiNodeType::time: + { + ImNodes::BeginNode(node.id); + + ImNodes::BeginNodeTitleBar(); + ImGui::TextUnformatted("time"); + ImNodes::EndNodeTitleBar(); + + ImNodes::BeginOutputAttribute(node.id); + ImGui::Text("output"); + ImNodes::EndOutputAttribute(); + + ImNodes::EndNode(); + } + break; + } + } + + for (const auto& edge : graph_.edges()) + { + // If edge doesn't start at value, then it's an internal edge, i.e. + // an edge which links a node's operation to its input. We don't + // want to render node internals with visible links. + if (graph_.node(edge.from).type != NodeType::value) + continue; + + ImNodes::Link(edge.id, edge.from, edge.to); + } + + ImNodes::MiniMap(0.2f, minimap_location_); + ImNodes::EndNodeEditor(); + + // Handle new links + // These are driven by Imnodes, so we place the code after EndNodeEditor(). + + { + int start_attr, end_attr; + if (ImNodes::IsLinkCreated(&start_attr, &end_attr)) + { + const NodeType start_type = graph_.node(start_attr).type; + const NodeType end_type = graph_.node(end_attr).type; + + const bool valid_link = start_type != end_type; + if (valid_link) + { + // Ensure the edge is always directed from the value to + // whatever produces the value + if (start_type != NodeType::value) + { + std::swap(start_attr, end_attr); + } + graph_.insert_edge(start_attr, end_attr); + } + } + } + + // Handle deleted links + + { + int link_id; + if (ImNodes::IsLinkDestroyed(&link_id)) + { + graph_.erase_edge(link_id); + } + } + + { + const int num_selected = ImNodes::NumSelectedLinks(); + if (num_selected > 0 && ImGui::IsKeyReleased(SDL_SCANCODE_X)) + { + static std::vector selected_links; + selected_links.resize(static_cast(num_selected)); + ImNodes::GetSelectedLinks(selected_links.data()); + for (const int edge_id : selected_links) + { + graph_.erase_edge(edge_id); + } + } + } + + { + const int num_selected = ImNodes::NumSelectedNodes(); + if (num_selected > 0 && ImGui::IsKeyReleased(SDL_SCANCODE_X)) + { + static std::vector selected_nodes; + selected_nodes.resize(static_cast(num_selected)); + ImNodes::GetSelectedNodes(selected_nodes.data()); + for (const int node_id : selected_nodes) + { + graph_.erase_node(node_id); + auto iter = std::find_if( + nodes_.begin(), nodes_.end(), [node_id](const UiNode& node) -> bool { + return node.id == node_id; + }); + // Erase any additional internal nodes + switch (iter->type) + { + case UiNodeType::add: + graph_.erase_node(iter->add.lhs); + graph_.erase_node(iter->add.rhs); + break; + case UiNodeType::multiply: + graph_.erase_node(iter->multiply.lhs); + graph_.erase_node(iter->multiply.rhs); + break; + case UiNodeType::output: + graph_.erase_node(iter->output.r); + graph_.erase_node(iter->output.g); + graph_.erase_node(iter->output.b); + root_node_id_ = -1; + break; + case UiNodeType::sine: + graph_.erase_node(iter->sine.input); + break; + default: + break; + } + nodes_.erase(iter); + } + } + } + + ImGui::End(); + + // The color output window + + const ImU32 color = + root_node_id_ != -1 ? evaluate(graph_, root_node_id_) : IM_COL32(255, 20, 147, 255); + ImGui::PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_WindowBg, color); + ImGui::Begin("output color"); + ImGui::End(); + ImGui::PopStyleColor(); + } + +private: + enum class UiNodeType + { + add, + multiply, + output, + sine, + time, + }; + + struct UiNode + { + UiNodeType type; + // The identifying id of the ui node. For add, multiply, sine, and time + // this is the "operation" node id. The additional input nodes are + // stored in the structs. + int id; + + union + { + struct + { + int lhs, rhs; + } add; + + struct + { + int lhs, rhs; + } multiply; + + struct + { + int r, g, b; + } output; + + struct + { + int input; + } sine; + }; + }; + + Graph graph_; + std::vector nodes_; + int root_node_id_; + ImNodesMiniMapLocation minimap_location_; +}; + +static ColorNodeEditor color_editor; +} // namespace + +void NodeEditorInitialize() +{ + ImNodesIO& io = ImNodes::GetIO(); + io.LinkDetachWithModifierClick.Modifier = &ImGui::GetIO().KeyCtrl; +} + +void NodeEditorShow() { color_editor.show(); } + +void NodeEditorShutdown() {} +} // namespace example diff --git a/3rdparty/imnodes/example/graph.h b/3rdparty/imnodes/example/graph.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000..35efdea --- /dev/null +++ b/3rdparty/imnodes/example/graph.h @@ -0,0 +1,357 @@ +#pragma once + +#include +#include +#include +#include +#include +#include +#include + +namespace example +{ +template +struct Span +{ + using iterator = ElementType*; + + template + Span(Container& c) : begin_(c.data()), end_(begin_ + c.size()) + { + } + + iterator begin() const { return begin_; } + iterator end() const { return end_; } + +private: + iterator begin_; + iterator end_; +}; + +template +class IdMap +{ +public: + using iterator = typename std::vector::iterator; + using const_iterator = typename std::vector::const_iterator; + + // Iterators + + const_iterator begin() const { return elements_.begin(); } + const_iterator end() const { return elements_.end(); } + + // Element access + + Span elements() const { return elements_; } + + // Capacity + + bool empty() const { return sorted_ids_.empty(); } + size_t size() const { return sorted_ids_.size(); } + + // Modifiers + + std::pair insert(int id, const ElementType& element); + std::pair insert(int id, ElementType&& element); + size_t erase(int id); + void clear(); + + // Lookup + + iterator find(int id); + const_iterator find(int id) const; + bool contains(int id) const; + +private: + std::vector elements_; + std::vector sorted_ids_; +}; + +template +std::pair::iterator, bool> IdMap::insert( + const int id, + const ElementType& element) +{ + auto lower_bound = std::lower_bound(sorted_ids_.begin(), sorted_ids_.end(), id); + + if (lower_bound != sorted_ids_.end() && id == *lower_bound) + { + return std::make_pair( + std::next(elements_.begin(), std::distance(sorted_ids_.begin(), lower_bound)), false); + } + + auto insert_element_at = + std::next(elements_.begin(), std::distance(sorted_ids_.begin(), lower_bound)); + + sorted_ids_.insert(lower_bound, id); + return std::make_pair(elements_.insert(insert_element_at, element), true); +} + +template +std::pair::iterator, bool> IdMap::insert( + const int id, + ElementType&& element) +{ + auto lower_bound = std::lower_bound(sorted_ids_.begin(), sorted_ids_.end(), id); + + if (lower_bound != sorted_ids_.end() && id == *lower_bound) + { + return std::make_pair( + std::next(elements_.begin(), std::distance(sorted_ids_.begin(), lower_bound)), false); + } + + auto insert_element_at = + std::next(elements_.begin(), std::distance(sorted_ids_.begin(), lower_bound)); + + sorted_ids_.insert(lower_bound, id); + return std::make_pair(elements_.insert(insert_element_at, std::move(element)), true); +} + +template +size_t IdMap::erase(const int id) +{ + auto lower_bound = std::lower_bound(sorted_ids_.begin(), sorted_ids_.end(), id); + + if (lower_bound == sorted_ids_.end() || id != *lower_bound) + { + return 0ull; + } + + auto erase_element_at = + std::next(elements_.begin(), std::distance(sorted_ids_.begin(), lower_bound)); + + sorted_ids_.erase(lower_bound); + elements_.erase(erase_element_at); + + return 1ull; +} + +template +void IdMap::clear() +{ + elements_.clear(); + sorted_ids_.clear(); +} + +template +typename IdMap::iterator IdMap::find(const int id) +{ + const auto lower_bound = std::lower_bound(sorted_ids_.cbegin(), sorted_ids_.cend(), id); + return (lower_bound == sorted_ids_.cend() || *lower_bound != id) + ? elements_.end() + : std::next(elements_.begin(), std::distance(sorted_ids_.cbegin(), lower_bound)); +} + +template +typename IdMap::const_iterator IdMap::find(const int id) const +{ + const auto lower_bound = std::lower_bound(sorted_ids_.cbegin(), sorted_ids_.cend(), id); + return (lower_bound == sorted_ids_.cend() || *lower_bound != id) + ? elements_.cend() + : std::next(elements_.cbegin(), std::distance(sorted_ids_.cbegin(), lower_bound)); +} + +template +bool IdMap::contains(const int id) const +{ + const auto lower_bound = std::lower_bound(sorted_ids_.cbegin(), sorted_ids_.cend(), id); + + if (lower_bound == sorted_ids_.cend()) + { + return false; + } + + return *lower_bound == id; +} + +// a very simple directional graph +template +class Graph +{ +public: + Graph() : current_id_(0), nodes_(), edges_from_node_(), node_neighbors_(), edges_() {} + + struct Edge + { + int id; + int from, to; + + Edge() = default; + Edge(const int id, const int f, const int t) : id(id), from(f), to(t) {} + + inline int opposite(const int n) const { return n == from ? to : from; } + inline bool contains(const int n) const { return n == from || n == to; } + }; + + // Element access + + NodeType& node(int node_id); + const NodeType& node(int node_id) const; + Span neighbors(int node_id) const; + Span edges() const; + + // Capacity + + size_t num_edges_from_node(int node_id) const; + + // Modifiers + + int insert_node(const NodeType& node); + void erase_node(int node_id); + + int insert_edge(int from, int to); + void erase_edge(int edge_id); + +private: + int current_id_; + // These contains map to the node id + IdMap nodes_; + IdMap edges_from_node_; + IdMap> node_neighbors_; + + // This container maps to the edge id + IdMap edges_; +}; + +template +NodeType& Graph::node(const int id) +{ + return const_cast(static_cast(this)->node(id)); +} + +template +const NodeType& Graph::node(const int id) const +{ + const auto iter = nodes_.find(id); + assert(iter != nodes_.end()); + return *iter; +} + +template +Span Graph::neighbors(int node_id) const +{ + const auto iter = node_neighbors_.find(node_id); + assert(iter != node_neighbors_.end()); + return *iter; +} + +template +Span::Edge> Graph::edges() const +{ + return edges_.elements(); +} + +template +size_t Graph::num_edges_from_node(const int id) const +{ + auto iter = edges_from_node_.find(id); + assert(iter != edges_from_node_.end()); + return *iter; +} + +template +int Graph::insert_node(const NodeType& node) +{ + const int id = current_id_++; + assert(!nodes_.contains(id)); + nodes_.insert(id, node); + edges_from_node_.insert(id, 0); + node_neighbors_.insert(id, std::vector()); + return id; +} + +template +void Graph::erase_node(const int id) +{ + + // first, remove any potential dangling edges + { + static std::vector edges_to_erase; + + for (const Edge& edge : edges_.elements()) + { + if (edge.contains(id)) + { + edges_to_erase.push_back(edge.id); + } + } + + for (const int edge_id : edges_to_erase) + { + erase_edge(edge_id); + } + + edges_to_erase.clear(); + } + + nodes_.erase(id); + edges_from_node_.erase(id); + node_neighbors_.erase(id); +} + +template +int Graph::insert_edge(const int from, const int to) +{ + const int id = current_id_++; + assert(!edges_.contains(id)); + assert(nodes_.contains(from)); + assert(nodes_.contains(to)); + edges_.insert(id, Edge(id, from, to)); + + // update neighbor count + assert(edges_from_node_.contains(from)); + *edges_from_node_.find(from) += 1; + // update neighbor list + assert(node_neighbors_.contains(from)); + node_neighbors_.find(from)->push_back(to); + + return id; +} + +template +void Graph::erase_edge(const int edge_id) +{ + // This is a bit lazy, we find the pointer here, but we refind it when we erase the edge based + // on id key. + assert(edges_.contains(edge_id)); + const Edge& edge = *edges_.find(edge_id); + + // update neighbor count + assert(edges_from_node_.contains(edge.from)); + int& edge_count = *edges_from_node_.find(edge.from); + assert(edge_count > 0); + edge_count -= 1; + + // update neighbor list + { + assert(node_neighbors_.contains(edge.from)); + auto neighbors = node_neighbors_.find(edge.from); + auto iter = std::find(neighbors->begin(), neighbors->end(), edge.to); + assert(iter != neighbors->end()); + neighbors->erase(iter); + } + + edges_.erase(edge_id); +} + +template +void dfs_traverse(const Graph& graph, const int start_node, Visitor visitor) +{ + std::stack stack; + + stack.push(start_node); + + while (!stack.empty()) + { + const int current_node = stack.top(); + stack.pop(); + + visitor(current_node); + + for (const int neighbor : graph.neighbors(current_node)) + { + stack.push(neighbor); + } + } +} +} // namespace example diff --git a/3rdparty/imnodes/example/hello.cpp b/3rdparty/imnodes/example/hello.cpp new file mode 100644 index 0000000..7a8619b --- /dev/null +++ b/3rdparty/imnodes/example/hello.cpp @@ -0,0 +1,48 @@ +#include "node_editor.h" +#include +#include + +namespace example +{ +namespace +{ +class HelloWorldNodeEditor +{ +public: + void show() + { + ImGui::Begin("simple node editor"); + + ImNodes::BeginNodeEditor(); + ImNodes::BeginNode(1); + + ImNodes::BeginNodeTitleBar(); + ImGui::TextUnformatted("simple node :)"); + ImNodes::EndNodeTitleBar(); + + ImNodes::BeginInputAttribute(2); + ImGui::Text("input"); + ImNodes::EndInputAttribute(); + + ImNodes::BeginOutputAttribute(3); + ImGui::Indent(40); + ImGui::Text("output"); + ImNodes::EndOutputAttribute(); + + ImNodes::EndNode(); + ImNodes::EndNodeEditor(); + + ImGui::End(); + } +}; + +static HelloWorldNodeEditor editor; +} // namespace + +void NodeEditorInitialize() { ImNodes::SetNodeGridSpacePos(1, ImVec2(200.0f, 200.0f)); } + +void NodeEditorShow() { editor.show(); } + +void NodeEditorShutdown() {} + +} // namespace example diff --git a/3rdparty/imnodes/example/main.cpp b/3rdparty/imnodes/example/main.cpp new file mode 100644 index 0000000..5ea1b8e --- /dev/null +++ b/3rdparty/imnodes/example/main.cpp @@ -0,0 +1,128 @@ +#include "node_editor.h" +#include +#include +#include +#include +#include +#include +#include + +int main(int, char**) +{ + if (SDL_Init(SDL_INIT_VIDEO | SDL_INIT_TIMER) != 0) + { + printf("Error: %s\n", SDL_GetError()); + return -1; + } + +#if __APPLE__ + // GL 3.2 Core + GLSL 150 + const char* glsl_version = "#version 150"; + SDL_GL_SetAttribute( + SDL_GL_CONTEXT_FLAGS, + SDL_GL_CONTEXT_FORWARD_COMPATIBLE_FLAG); // Always required on Mac + SDL_GL_SetAttribute(SDL_GL_CONTEXT_PROFILE_MASK, SDL_GL_CONTEXT_PROFILE_CORE); + SDL_GL_SetAttribute(SDL_GL_CONTEXT_MAJOR_VERSION, 3); + SDL_GL_SetAttribute(SDL_GL_CONTEXT_MINOR_VERSION, 2); +#else + // GL 3.0 + GLSL 130 + const char* glsl_version = "#version 130"; + SDL_GL_SetAttribute(SDL_GL_CONTEXT_FLAGS, 0); + SDL_GL_SetAttribute(SDL_GL_CONTEXT_PROFILE_MASK, SDL_GL_CONTEXT_PROFILE_CORE); + SDL_GL_SetAttribute(SDL_GL_CONTEXT_MAJOR_VERSION, 3); + SDL_GL_SetAttribute(SDL_GL_CONTEXT_MINOR_VERSION, 0); +#endif + + SDL_GL_SetAttribute(SDL_GL_DOUBLEBUFFER, 1); + SDL_GL_SetAttribute(SDL_GL_DEPTH_SIZE, 24); + SDL_GL_SetAttribute(SDL_GL_STENCIL_SIZE, 8); + SDL_DisplayMode current; + SDL_GetCurrentDisplayMode(0, ¤t); + SDL_Window* window = SDL_CreateWindow( + "imgui-node-editor example", + SDL_WINDOWPOS_CENTERED, + SDL_WINDOWPOS_CENTERED, + 1280, + 720, + SDL_WINDOW_OPENGL | SDL_WINDOW_RESIZABLE | SDL_WINDOW_ALLOW_HIGHDPI); + SDL_GLContext gl_context = SDL_GL_CreateContext(window); + SDL_GL_MakeCurrent(window, gl_context); + SDL_GL_SetSwapInterval(1); // Enable vsync + + if (gl3wInit()) + { + fprintf(stderr, "Failed to initialize OpenGL loader!\n"); + return 1; + } + + IMGUI_CHECKVERSION(); + ImGui::CreateContext(); + + ImGui_ImplSDL2_InitForOpenGL(window, gl_context); + ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_Init(glsl_version); + + ImNodes::CreateContext(); + + // Setup style + ImGui::StyleColorsDark(); + ImNodes::StyleColorsDark(); + + bool done = false; + bool initialized = false; + + { + const ImVec4 clear_color = ImVec4(0.45f, 0.55f, 0.60f, 1.00f); + glClearColor(clear_color.x, clear_color.y, clear_color.z, clear_color.w); + } + + while (!done) + { + SDL_Event event; + while (SDL_PollEvent(&event)) + { + ImGui_ImplSDL2_ProcessEvent(&event); + if (event.type == SDL_QUIT) + done = true; + if (event.type == SDL_WINDOWEVENT && event.window.event == SDL_WINDOWEVENT_CLOSE && + event.window.windowID == SDL_GetWindowID(window)) + done = true; + } + + // Start the Dear ImGui frame + ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_NewFrame(); + ImGui_ImplSDL2_NewFrame(); + ImGui::NewFrame(); + + if (!initialized) + { + initialized = true; + example::NodeEditorInitialize(); + } + + example::NodeEditorShow(); + + // Rendering + ImGui::Render(); + + int fb_width, fb_height; + SDL_GL_GetDrawableSize(window, &fb_width, &fb_height); + glViewport(0, 0, fb_width, fb_height); + glClear(GL_COLOR_BUFFER_BIT); + + ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_RenderDrawData(ImGui::GetDrawData()); + SDL_GL_SwapWindow(window); + } + + example::NodeEditorShutdown(); + ImNodes::DestroyContext(); + + ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_Shutdown(); + ImGui_ImplSDL2_Shutdown(); + ImGui::DestroyContext(); + + SDL_GL_DeleteContext(gl_context); + SDL_DestroyWindow(window); + SDL_Quit(); + + return 0; +} diff --git a/3rdparty/imnodes/example/multi_editor.cpp b/3rdparty/imnodes/example/multi_editor.cpp new file mode 100644 index 0000000..e9483a5 --- /dev/null +++ b/3rdparty/imnodes/example/multi_editor.cpp @@ -0,0 +1,137 @@ +#include "node_editor.h" +#include +#include +#include + +#include +#include + +namespace example +{ +namespace +{ +struct Node +{ + int id; + float value; + + Node(const int i, const float v) : id(i), value(v) {} +}; + +struct Link +{ + int id; + int start_attr, end_attr; +}; + +struct Editor +{ + ImNodesEditorContext* context = nullptr; + std::vector nodes; + std::vector links; + int current_id = 0; +}; + +void show_editor(const char* editor_name, Editor& editor) +{ + ImNodes::EditorContextSet(editor.context); + + ImGui::Begin(editor_name); + ImGui::TextUnformatted("A -- add node"); + + ImNodes::BeginNodeEditor(); + + if (ImGui::IsWindowFocused(ImGuiFocusedFlags_RootAndChildWindows) && + ImNodes::IsEditorHovered() && ImGui::IsKeyReleased(SDL_SCANCODE_A)) + { + const int node_id = ++editor.current_id; + ImNodes::SetNodeScreenSpacePos(node_id, ImGui::GetMousePos()); + editor.nodes.push_back(Node(node_id, 0.f)); + } + + for (Node& node : editor.nodes) + { + ImNodes::BeginNode(node.id); + + ImNodes::BeginNodeTitleBar(); + ImGui::TextUnformatted("node"); + ImNodes::EndNodeTitleBar(); + + ImNodes::BeginInputAttribute(node.id << 8); + ImGui::TextUnformatted("input"); + ImNodes::EndInputAttribute(); + + ImNodes::BeginStaticAttribute(node.id << 16); + ImGui::PushItemWidth(120.0f); + ImGui::DragFloat("value", &node.value, 0.01f); + ImGui::PopItemWidth(); + ImNodes::EndStaticAttribute(); + + ImNodes::BeginOutputAttribute(node.id << 24); + const float text_width = ImGui::CalcTextSize("output").x; + ImGui::Indent(120.f + ImGui::CalcTextSize("value").x - text_width); + ImGui::TextUnformatted("output"); + ImNodes::EndOutputAttribute(); + + ImNodes::EndNode(); + } + + for (const Link& link : editor.links) + { + ImNodes::Link(link.id, link.start_attr, link.end_attr); + } + + ImNodes::EndNodeEditor(); + + { + Link link; + if (ImNodes::IsLinkCreated(&link.start_attr, &link.end_attr)) + { + link.id = ++editor.current_id; + editor.links.push_back(link); + } + } + + { + int link_id; + if (ImNodes::IsLinkDestroyed(&link_id)) + { + auto iter = std::find_if( + editor.links.begin(), editor.links.end(), [link_id](const Link& link) -> bool { + return link.id == link_id; + }); + assert(iter != editor.links.end()); + editor.links.erase(iter); + } + } + + ImGui::End(); +} + +Editor editor1; +Editor editor2; +} // namespace + +void NodeEditorInitialize() +{ + editor1.context = ImNodes::EditorContextCreate(); + editor2.context = ImNodes::EditorContextCreate(); + ImNodes::PushAttributeFlag(ImNodesAttributeFlags_EnableLinkDetachWithDragClick); + + ImNodesIO& io = ImNodes::GetIO(); + io.LinkDetachWithModifierClick.Modifier = &ImGui::GetIO().KeyCtrl; +} + +void NodeEditorShow() +{ + show_editor("editor1", editor1); + show_editor("editor2", editor2); +} + +void NodeEditorShutdown() +{ + ImNodes::PopAttributeFlag(); + ImNodes::EditorContextFree(editor1.context); + ImNodes::EditorContextFree(editor2.context); +} +} // namespace example diff --git a/3rdparty/imnodes/example/node_editor.h b/3rdparty/imnodes/example/node_editor.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000..80328a4 --- /dev/null +++ b/3rdparty/imnodes/example/node_editor.h @@ -0,0 +1,8 @@ +#pragma once + +namespace example +{ +void NodeEditorInitialize(); +void NodeEditorShow(); +void NodeEditorShutdown(); +} // namespace example \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/3rdparty/imnodes/example/save_load.cpp b/3rdparty/imnodes/example/save_load.cpp new file mode 100644 index 0000000..7a21376 --- /dev/null +++ b/3rdparty/imnodes/example/save_load.cpp @@ -0,0 +1,206 @@ +#include "node_editor.h" + +#include +#include +#include + +#include +#include +#include +#include // for std::streamsize +#include +#include + +namespace example +{ +namespace +{ +struct Node +{ + int id; + float value; + + Node() = default; + + Node(const int i, const float v) : id(i), value(v) {} +}; + +struct Link +{ + int id; + int start_attr, end_attr; +}; + +class SaveLoadEditor +{ +public: + SaveLoadEditor() : nodes_(), links_(), current_id_(0) {} + + void show() + { + ImGui::Begin("Save & load example"); + ImGui::TextUnformatted("A -- add node"); + ImGui::TextUnformatted( + "Close the executable and rerun it -- your nodes should be exactly " + "where you left them!"); + + ImNodes::BeginNodeEditor(); + + if (ImGui::IsWindowFocused(ImGuiFocusedFlags_RootAndChildWindows) && + ImNodes::IsEditorHovered() && ImGui::IsKeyReleased(SDL_SCANCODE_A)) + { + const int node_id = ++current_id_; + ImNodes::SetNodeScreenSpacePos(node_id, ImGui::GetMousePos()); + nodes_.push_back(Node(node_id, 0.f)); + } + + for (Node& node : nodes_) + { + ImNodes::BeginNode(node.id); + + ImNodes::BeginNodeTitleBar(); + ImGui::TextUnformatted("node"); + ImNodes::EndNodeTitleBar(); + + ImNodes::BeginInputAttribute(node.id << 8); + ImGui::TextUnformatted("input"); + ImNodes::EndInputAttribute(); + + ImNodes::BeginStaticAttribute(node.id << 16); + ImGui::PushItemWidth(120.f); + ImGui::DragFloat("value", &node.value, 0.01f); + ImGui::PopItemWidth(); + ImNodes::EndStaticAttribute(); + + ImNodes::BeginOutputAttribute(node.id << 24); + const float text_width = ImGui::CalcTextSize("output").x; + ImGui::Indent(120.f + ImGui::CalcTextSize("value").x - text_width); + ImGui::TextUnformatted("output"); + ImNodes::EndOutputAttribute(); + + ImNodes::EndNode(); + } + + for (const Link& link : links_) + { + ImNodes::Link(link.id, link.start_attr, link.end_attr); + } + + ImNodes::EndNodeEditor(); + + { + Link link; + if (ImNodes::IsLinkCreated(&link.start_attr, &link.end_attr)) + { + link.id = ++current_id_; + links_.push_back(link); + } + } + + { + int link_id; + if (ImNodes::IsLinkDestroyed(&link_id)) + { + auto iter = + std::find_if(links_.begin(), links_.end(), [link_id](const Link& link) -> bool { + return link.id == link_id; + }); + assert(iter != links_.end()); + links_.erase(iter); + } + } + + ImGui::End(); + } + + void save() + { + // Save the internal imnodes state + ImNodes::SaveCurrentEditorStateToIniFile("save_load.ini"); + + // Dump our editor state as bytes into a file + + std::fstream fout( + "save_load.bytes", std::ios_base::out | std::ios_base::binary | std::ios_base::trunc); + + // copy the node vector to file + const size_t num_nodes = nodes_.size(); + fout.write( + reinterpret_cast(&num_nodes), + static_cast(sizeof(size_t))); + fout.write( + reinterpret_cast(nodes_.data()), + static_cast(sizeof(Node) * num_nodes)); + + // copy the link vector to file + const size_t num_links = links_.size(); + fout.write( + reinterpret_cast(&num_links), + static_cast(sizeof(size_t))); + fout.write( + reinterpret_cast(links_.data()), + static_cast(sizeof(Link) * num_links)); + + // copy the current_id to file + fout.write( + reinterpret_cast(¤t_id_), static_cast(sizeof(int))); + } + + void load() + { + // Load the internal imnodes state + ImNodes::LoadCurrentEditorStateFromIniFile("save_load.ini"); + + // Load our editor state into memory + + std::fstream fin("save_load.bytes", std::ios_base::in | std::ios_base::binary); + + if (!fin.is_open()) + { + return; + } + + // copy nodes into memory + size_t num_nodes; + fin.read(reinterpret_cast(&num_nodes), static_cast(sizeof(size_t))); + nodes_.resize(num_nodes); + fin.read( + reinterpret_cast(nodes_.data()), + static_cast(sizeof(Node) * num_nodes)); + + // copy links into memory + size_t num_links; + fin.read(reinterpret_cast(&num_links), static_cast(sizeof(size_t))); + links_.resize(num_links); + fin.read( + reinterpret_cast(links_.data()), + static_cast(sizeof(Link) * num_links)); + + // copy current_id into memory + fin.read(reinterpret_cast(¤t_id_), static_cast(sizeof(int))); + } + +private: + std::vector nodes_; + std::vector links_; + int current_id_; +}; + +static SaveLoadEditor editor; +} // namespace + +void NodeEditorInitialize() +{ + ImNodes::GetIO().LinkDetachWithModifierClick.Modifier = &ImGui::GetIO().KeyCtrl; + ImNodes::PushAttributeFlag(ImNodesAttributeFlags_EnableLinkDetachWithDragClick); + editor.load(); +} + +void NodeEditorShow() { editor.show(); } + +void NodeEditorShutdown() +{ + ImNodes::PopAttributeFlag(); + editor.save(); +} +} // namespace example diff --git a/3rdparty/imnodes/img/imnodes.gif b/3rdparty/imnodes/img/imnodes.gif new file mode 100644 index 0000000..6163688 Binary files /dev/null and b/3rdparty/imnodes/img/imnodes.gif differ diff --git a/3rdparty/imnodes/imnodes.cpp b/3rdparty/imnodes/imnodes.cpp new file mode 100644 index 0000000..c9c1638 --- /dev/null +++ b/3rdparty/imnodes/imnodes.cpp @@ -0,0 +1,3175 @@ +// the structure of this file: +// +// [SECTION] bezier curve helpers +// [SECTION] draw list helper +// [SECTION] ui state logic +// [SECTION] render helpers +// [SECTION] API implementation + +#include "imnodes.h" +#include "imnodes_internal.h" + +#define IMGUI_DEFINE_MATH_OPERATORS +#include + +// Check minimum ImGui version +#define MINIMUM_COMPATIBLE_IMGUI_VERSION 17400 +#if IMGUI_VERSION_NUM < MINIMUM_COMPATIBLE_IMGUI_VERSION +#error "Minimum ImGui version requirement not met -- please use a newer version!" +#endif + +#include +#include +#include +#include +#include +#include // for fwrite, ssprintf, sscanf +#include +#include // strlen, strncmp + +ImNodesContext* GImNodes = NULL; + +namespace IMNODES_NAMESPACE +{ +namespace +{ +// [SECTION] bezier curve helpers + +struct CubicBezier +{ + ImVec2 P0, P1, P2, P3; + int NumSegments; +}; + +inline ImVec2 EvalCubicBezier( + const float t, + const ImVec2& P0, + const ImVec2& P1, + const ImVec2& P2, + const ImVec2& P3) +{ + // B(t) = (1-t)**3 p0 + 3(1 - t)**2 t P1 + 3(1-t)t**2 P2 + t**3 P3 + + const float u = 1.0f - t; + const float b0 = u * u * u; + const float b1 = 3 * u * u * t; + const float b2 = 3 * u * t * t; + const float b3 = t * t * t; + return ImVec2( + b0 * P0.x + b1 * P1.x + b2 * P2.x + b3 * P3.x, + b0 * P0.y + b1 * P1.y + b2 * P2.y + b3 * P3.y); +} + +// Calculates the closest point along each bezier curve segment. +ImVec2 GetClosestPointOnCubicBezier(const int num_segments, const ImVec2& p, const CubicBezier& cb) +{ + IM_ASSERT(num_segments > 0); + ImVec2 p_last = cb.P0; + ImVec2 p_closest; + float p_closest_dist = FLT_MAX; + float t_step = 1.0f / (float)num_segments; + for (int i = 1; i <= num_segments; ++i) + { + ImVec2 p_current = EvalCubicBezier(t_step * i, cb.P0, cb.P1, cb.P2, cb.P3); + ImVec2 p_line = ImLineClosestPoint(p_last, p_current, p); + float dist = ImLengthSqr(p - p_line); + if (dist < p_closest_dist) + { + p_closest = p_line; + p_closest_dist = dist; + } + p_last = p_current; + } + return p_closest; +} + +inline float GetDistanceToCubicBezier( + const ImVec2& pos, + const CubicBezier& cubic_bezier, + const int num_segments) +{ + const ImVec2 point_on_curve = GetClosestPointOnCubicBezier(num_segments, pos, cubic_bezier); + + const ImVec2 to_curve = point_on_curve - pos; + return ImSqrt(ImLengthSqr(to_curve)); +} + +inline ImRect GetContainingRectForCubicBezier(const CubicBezier& cb) +{ + const ImVec2 min = ImVec2(ImMin(cb.P0.x, cb.P3.x), ImMin(cb.P0.y, cb.P3.y)); + const ImVec2 max = ImVec2(ImMax(cb.P0.x, cb.P3.x), ImMax(cb.P0.y, cb.P3.y)); + + const float hover_distance = GImNodes->Style.LinkHoverDistance; + + ImRect rect(min, max); + rect.Add(cb.P1); + rect.Add(cb.P2); + rect.Expand(ImVec2(hover_distance, hover_distance)); + + return rect; +} + +inline CubicBezier GetCubicBezier( + ImVec2 start, + ImVec2 end, + const ImNodesAttributeType start_type, + const float line_segments_per_length) +{ + assert( + (start_type == ImNodesAttributeType_Input) || (start_type == ImNodesAttributeType_Output)); + if (start_type == ImNodesAttributeType_Input) + { + ImSwap(start, end); + } + + const float link_length = ImSqrt(ImLengthSqr(end - start)); + const ImVec2 offset = ImVec2(0.25f * link_length, 0.f); + CubicBezier cubic_bezier; + cubic_bezier.P0 = start; + cubic_bezier.P1 = start + offset; + cubic_bezier.P2 = end - offset; + cubic_bezier.P3 = end; + cubic_bezier.NumSegments = ImMax(static_cast(link_length * line_segments_per_length), 1); + return cubic_bezier; +} + +inline float EvalImplicitLineEq(const ImVec2& p1, const ImVec2& p2, const ImVec2& p) +{ + return (p2.y - p1.y) * p.x + (p1.x - p2.x) * p.y + (p2.x * p1.y - p1.x * p2.y); +} + +inline int Sign(float val) { return int(val > 0.0f) - int(val < 0.0f); } + +inline bool RectangleOverlapsLineSegment(const ImRect& rect, const ImVec2& p1, const ImVec2& p2) +{ + // Trivial case: rectangle contains an endpoint + if (rect.Contains(p1) || rect.Contains(p2)) + { + return true; + } + + // Flip rectangle if necessary + ImRect flip_rect = rect; + + if (flip_rect.Min.x > flip_rect.Max.x) + { + ImSwap(flip_rect.Min.x, flip_rect.Max.x); + } + + if (flip_rect.Min.y > flip_rect.Max.y) + { + ImSwap(flip_rect.Min.y, flip_rect.Max.y); + } + + // Trivial case: line segment lies to one particular side of rectangle + if ((p1.x < flip_rect.Min.x && p2.x < flip_rect.Min.x) || + (p1.x > flip_rect.Max.x && p2.x > flip_rect.Max.x) || + (p1.y < flip_rect.Min.y && p2.y < flip_rect.Min.y) || + (p1.y > flip_rect.Max.y && p2.y > flip_rect.Max.y)) + { + return false; + } + + const int corner_signs[4] = { + Sign(EvalImplicitLineEq(p1, p2, flip_rect.Min)), + Sign(EvalImplicitLineEq(p1, p2, ImVec2(flip_rect.Max.x, flip_rect.Min.y))), + Sign(EvalImplicitLineEq(p1, p2, ImVec2(flip_rect.Min.x, flip_rect.Max.y))), + Sign(EvalImplicitLineEq(p1, p2, flip_rect.Max))}; + + int sum = 0; + int sum_abs = 0; + + for (int i = 0; i < 4; ++i) + { + sum += corner_signs[i]; + sum_abs += abs(corner_signs[i]); + } + + // At least one corner of rectangle lies on a different side of line segment + return abs(sum) != sum_abs; +} + +inline bool RectangleOverlapsBezier(const ImRect& rectangle, const CubicBezier& cubic_bezier) +{ + ImVec2 current = + EvalCubicBezier(0.f, cubic_bezier.P0, cubic_bezier.P1, cubic_bezier.P2, cubic_bezier.P3); + const float dt = 1.0f / cubic_bezier.NumSegments; + for (int s = 0; s < cubic_bezier.NumSegments; ++s) + { + ImVec2 next = EvalCubicBezier( + static_cast((s + 1) * dt), + cubic_bezier.P0, + cubic_bezier.P1, + cubic_bezier.P2, + cubic_bezier.P3); + if (RectangleOverlapsLineSegment(rectangle, current, next)) + { + return true; + } + current = next; + } + return false; +} + +inline bool RectangleOverlapsLink( + const ImRect& rectangle, + const ImVec2& start, + const ImVec2& end, + const ImNodesAttributeType start_type) +{ + // First level: simple rejection test via rectangle overlap: + + ImRect lrect = ImRect(start, end); + if (lrect.Min.x > lrect.Max.x) + { + ImSwap(lrect.Min.x, lrect.Max.x); + } + + if (lrect.Min.y > lrect.Max.y) + { + ImSwap(lrect.Min.y, lrect.Max.y); + } + + if (rectangle.Overlaps(lrect)) + { + // First, check if either one or both endpoinds are trivially contained + // in the rectangle + + if (rectangle.Contains(start) || rectangle.Contains(end)) + { + return true; + } + + // Second level of refinement: do a more expensive test against the + // link + + const CubicBezier cubic_bezier = + GetCubicBezier(start, end, start_type, GImNodes->Style.LinkLineSegmentsPerLength); + return RectangleOverlapsBezier(rectangle, cubic_bezier); + } + + return false; +} + +// [SECTION] coordinate space conversion helpers + +inline ImVec2 ScreenSpaceToGridSpace(const ImNodesEditorContext& editor, const ImVec2& v) +{ + return v - GImNodes->CanvasOriginScreenSpace - editor.Panning; +} + +inline ImRect ScreenSpaceToGridSpace(const ImNodesEditorContext& editor, const ImRect& r) +{ + return ImRect(ScreenSpaceToGridSpace(editor, r.Min), ScreenSpaceToGridSpace(editor, r.Max)); +} + +inline ImVec2 GridSpaceToScreenSpace(const ImNodesEditorContext& editor, const ImVec2& v) +{ + return v + GImNodes->CanvasOriginScreenSpace + editor.Panning; +} + +inline ImVec2 GridSpaceToEditorSpace(const ImNodesEditorContext& editor, const ImVec2& v) +{ + return v + editor.Panning; +} + +inline ImVec2 EditorSpaceToGridSpace(const ImNodesEditorContext& editor, const ImVec2& v) +{ + return v - editor.Panning; +} + +inline ImVec2 EditorSpaceToScreenSpace(const ImVec2& v) +{ + return GImNodes->CanvasOriginScreenSpace + v; +} + +inline ImVec2 MiniMapSpaceToGridSpace(const ImNodesEditorContext& editor, const ImVec2& v) +{ + return (v - editor.MiniMapContentScreenSpace.Min) / editor.MiniMapScaling + + editor.GridContentBounds.Min; +}; + +inline ImVec2 ScreenSpaceToMiniMapSpace(const ImNodesEditorContext& editor, const ImVec2& v) +{ + return (ScreenSpaceToGridSpace(editor, v) - editor.GridContentBounds.Min) * + editor.MiniMapScaling + + editor.MiniMapContentScreenSpace.Min; +}; + +inline ImRect ScreenSpaceToMiniMapSpace(const ImNodesEditorContext& editor, const ImRect& r) +{ + return ImRect( + ScreenSpaceToMiniMapSpace(editor, r.Min), ScreenSpaceToMiniMapSpace(editor, r.Max)); +}; + +// [SECTION] draw list helper + +void ImDrawListGrowChannels(ImDrawList* draw_list, const int num_channels) +{ + ImDrawListSplitter& splitter = draw_list->_Splitter; + + if (splitter._Count == 1) + { + splitter.Split(draw_list, num_channels + 1); + return; + } + + // NOTE: this logic has been lifted from ImDrawListSplitter::Split with slight modifications + // to allow nested splits. The main modification is that we only create new ImDrawChannel + // instances after splitter._Count, instead of over the whole splitter._Channels array like + // the regular ImDrawListSplitter::Split method does. + + const int old_channel_capacity = splitter._Channels.Size; + // NOTE: _Channels is not resized down, and therefore _Count <= _Channels.size()! + const int old_channel_count = splitter._Count; + const int requested_channel_count = old_channel_count + num_channels; + if (old_channel_capacity < old_channel_count + num_channels) + { + splitter._Channels.resize(requested_channel_count); + } + + splitter._Count = requested_channel_count; + + for (int i = old_channel_count; i < requested_channel_count; ++i) + { + ImDrawChannel& channel = splitter._Channels[i]; + + // If we're inside the old capacity region of the array, we need to reuse the existing + // memory of the command and index buffers. + if (i < old_channel_capacity) + { + channel._CmdBuffer.resize(0); + channel._IdxBuffer.resize(0); + } + // Else, we need to construct new draw channels. + else + { + IM_PLACEMENT_NEW(&channel) ImDrawChannel(); + } + + { + ImDrawCmd draw_cmd; + draw_cmd.ClipRect = draw_list->_ClipRectStack.back(); + draw_cmd.TextureId = draw_list->_TextureIdStack.back(); + channel._CmdBuffer.push_back(draw_cmd); + } + } +} + +void ImDrawListSplitterSwapChannels( + ImDrawListSplitter& splitter, + const int lhs_idx, + const int rhs_idx) +{ + if (lhs_idx == rhs_idx) + { + return; + } + + assert(lhs_idx >= 0 && lhs_idx < splitter._Count); + assert(rhs_idx >= 0 && rhs_idx < splitter._Count); + + ImDrawChannel& lhs_channel = splitter._Channels[lhs_idx]; + ImDrawChannel& rhs_channel = splitter._Channels[rhs_idx]; + lhs_channel._CmdBuffer.swap(rhs_channel._CmdBuffer); + lhs_channel._IdxBuffer.swap(rhs_channel._IdxBuffer); + + const int current_channel = splitter._Current; + + if (current_channel == lhs_idx) + { + splitter._Current = rhs_idx; + } + else if (current_channel == rhs_idx) + { + splitter._Current = lhs_idx; + } +} + +void DrawListSet(ImDrawList* window_draw_list) +{ + GImNodes->CanvasDrawList = window_draw_list; + GImNodes->NodeIdxToSubmissionIdx.Clear(); + GImNodes->NodeIdxSubmissionOrder.clear(); +} + +// The draw list channels are structured as follows. First we have our base channel, the canvas grid +// on which we render the grid lines in BeginNodeEditor(). The base channel is the reason +// draw_list_submission_idx_to_background_channel_idx offsets the index by one. Each BeginNode() +// call appends two new draw channels, for the node background and foreground. The node foreground +// is the channel into which the node's ImGui content is rendered. Finally, in EndNodeEditor() we +// append one last draw channel for rendering the selection box and the incomplete link on top of +// everything else. +// +// +----------+----------+----------+----------+----------+----------+ +// | | | | | | | +// |canvas |node |node |... |... |click | +// |grid |background|foreground| | |interaction +// | | | | | | | +// +----------+----------+----------+----------+----------+----------+ +// | | +// | submission idx | +// | | +// ----------------------- + +void DrawListAddNode(const int node_idx) +{ + GImNodes->NodeIdxToSubmissionIdx.SetInt( + static_cast(node_idx), GImNodes->NodeIdxSubmissionOrder.Size); + GImNodes->NodeIdxSubmissionOrder.push_back(node_idx); + ImDrawListGrowChannels(GImNodes->CanvasDrawList, 2); +} + +void DrawListAppendClickInteractionChannel() +{ + // NOTE: don't use this function outside of EndNodeEditor. Using this before all nodes have been + // added will screw up the node draw order. + ImDrawListGrowChannels(GImNodes->CanvasDrawList, 1); +} + +int DrawListSubmissionIdxToBackgroundChannelIdx(const int submission_idx) +{ + // NOTE: the first channel is the canvas background, i.e. the grid + return 1 + 2 * submission_idx; +} + +int DrawListSubmissionIdxToForegroundChannelIdx(const int submission_idx) +{ + return DrawListSubmissionIdxToBackgroundChannelIdx(submission_idx) + 1; +} + +void DrawListActivateClickInteractionChannel() +{ + GImNodes->CanvasDrawList->_Splitter.SetCurrentChannel( + GImNodes->CanvasDrawList, GImNodes->CanvasDrawList->_Splitter._Count - 1); +} + +void DrawListActivateCurrentNodeForeground() +{ + const int foreground_channel_idx = + DrawListSubmissionIdxToForegroundChannelIdx(GImNodes->NodeIdxSubmissionOrder.Size - 1); + GImNodes->CanvasDrawList->_Splitter.SetCurrentChannel( + GImNodes->CanvasDrawList, foreground_channel_idx); +} + +void DrawListActivateNodeBackground(const int node_idx) +{ + const int submission_idx = + GImNodes->NodeIdxToSubmissionIdx.GetInt(static_cast(node_idx), -1); + // There is a discrepancy in the submitted node count and the rendered node count! Did you call + // one of the following functions + // * EditorContextMoveToNode + // * SetNodeScreenSpacePos + // * SetNodeGridSpacePos + // * SetNodeDraggable + // after the BeginNode/EndNode function calls? + assert(submission_idx != -1); + const int background_channel_idx = DrawListSubmissionIdxToBackgroundChannelIdx(submission_idx); + GImNodes->CanvasDrawList->_Splitter.SetCurrentChannel( + GImNodes->CanvasDrawList, background_channel_idx); +} + +void DrawListSwapSubmissionIndices(const int lhs_idx, const int rhs_idx) +{ + assert(lhs_idx != rhs_idx); + + const int lhs_foreground_channel_idx = DrawListSubmissionIdxToForegroundChannelIdx(lhs_idx); + const int lhs_background_channel_idx = DrawListSubmissionIdxToBackgroundChannelIdx(lhs_idx); + const int rhs_foreground_channel_idx = DrawListSubmissionIdxToForegroundChannelIdx(rhs_idx); + const int rhs_background_channel_idx = DrawListSubmissionIdxToBackgroundChannelIdx(rhs_idx); + + ImDrawListSplitterSwapChannels( + GImNodes->CanvasDrawList->_Splitter, + lhs_background_channel_idx, + rhs_background_channel_idx); + ImDrawListSplitterSwapChannels( + GImNodes->CanvasDrawList->_Splitter, + lhs_foreground_channel_idx, + rhs_foreground_channel_idx); +} + +void DrawListSortChannelsByDepth(const ImVector& node_idx_depth_order) +{ + if (GImNodes->NodeIdxToSubmissionIdx.Data.Size < 2) + { + return; + } + + assert(node_idx_depth_order.Size == GImNodes->NodeIdxSubmissionOrder.Size); + + int start_idx = node_idx_depth_order.Size - 1; + + while (node_idx_depth_order[start_idx] == GImNodes->NodeIdxSubmissionOrder[start_idx]) + { + if (--start_idx == 0) + { + // early out if submission order and depth order are the same + return; + } + } + + // TODO: this is an O(N^2) algorithm. It might be worthwhile revisiting this to see if the time + // complexity can be reduced. + + for (int depth_idx = start_idx; depth_idx > 0; --depth_idx) + { + const int node_idx = node_idx_depth_order[depth_idx]; + + // Find the current index of the node_idx in the submission order array + int submission_idx = -1; + for (int i = 0; i < GImNodes->NodeIdxSubmissionOrder.Size; ++i) + { + if (GImNodes->NodeIdxSubmissionOrder[i] == node_idx) + { + submission_idx = i; + break; + } + } + assert(submission_idx >= 0); + + if (submission_idx == depth_idx) + { + continue; + } + + for (int j = submission_idx; j < depth_idx; ++j) + { + DrawListSwapSubmissionIndices(j, j + 1); + ImSwap(GImNodes->NodeIdxSubmissionOrder[j], GImNodes->NodeIdxSubmissionOrder[j + 1]); + } + } +} + +// [SECTION] ui state logic + +ImVec2 GetScreenSpacePinCoordinates( + const ImRect& node_rect, + const ImRect& attribute_rect, + const ImNodesAttributeType type) +{ + assert(type == ImNodesAttributeType_Input || type == ImNodesAttributeType_Output); + const float x = type == ImNodesAttributeType_Input + ? (node_rect.Min.x - GImNodes->Style.PinOffset) + : (node_rect.Max.x + GImNodes->Style.PinOffset); + return ImVec2(x, 0.5f * (attribute_rect.Min.y + attribute_rect.Max.y)); +} + +ImVec2 GetScreenSpacePinCoordinates(const ImNodesEditorContext& editor, const ImPinData& pin) +{ + const ImRect& parent_node_rect = editor.Nodes.Pool[pin.ParentNodeIdx].Rect; + return GetScreenSpacePinCoordinates(parent_node_rect, pin.AttributeRect, pin.Type); +} + +bool MouseInCanvas() +{ + // This flag should be true either when hovering or clicking something in the canvas. + const bool is_window_hovered_or_focused = ImGui::IsWindowHovered() || ImGui::IsWindowFocused(); + + return is_window_hovered_or_focused && + GImNodes->CanvasRectScreenSpace.Contains(ImGui::GetMousePos()); +} + +void BeginNodeSelection(ImNodesEditorContext& editor, const int node_idx) +{ + // Don't start selecting a node if we are e.g. already creating and dragging + // a new link! New link creation can happen when the mouse is clicked over + // a node, but within the hover radius of a pin. + if (editor.ClickInteraction.Type != ImNodesClickInteractionType_None) + { + return; + } + + editor.ClickInteraction.Type = ImNodesClickInteractionType_Node; + // If the node is not already contained in the selection, then we want only + // the interaction node to be selected, effective immediately. + // + // Otherwise, we want to allow for the possibility of multiple nodes to be + // moved at once. + if (!editor.SelectedNodeIndices.contains(node_idx)) + { + editor.SelectedNodeIndices.clear(); + editor.SelectedLinkIndices.clear(); + editor.SelectedNodeIndices.push_back(node_idx); + + // Ensure that individually selected nodes get rendered on top + ImVector& depth_stack = editor.NodeDepthOrder; + const int* const elem = depth_stack.find(node_idx); + assert(elem != depth_stack.end()); + depth_stack.erase(elem); + depth_stack.push_back(node_idx); + } +} + +void BeginLinkSelection(ImNodesEditorContext& editor, const int link_idx) +{ + editor.ClickInteraction.Type = ImNodesClickInteractionType_Link; + // When a link is selected, clear all other selections, and insert the link + // as the sole selection. + editor.SelectedNodeIndices.clear(); + editor.SelectedLinkIndices.clear(); + editor.SelectedLinkIndices.push_back(link_idx); +} + +void BeginLinkDetach(ImNodesEditorContext& editor, const int link_idx, const int detach_pin_idx) +{ + const ImLinkData& link = editor.Links.Pool[link_idx]; + ImClickInteractionState& state = editor.ClickInteraction; + state.Type = ImNodesClickInteractionType_LinkCreation; + state.LinkCreation.EndPinIdx.Reset(); + state.LinkCreation.StartPinIdx = + detach_pin_idx == link.StartPinIdx ? link.EndPinIdx : link.StartPinIdx; + GImNodes->DeletedLinkIdx = link_idx; +} + +void BeginLinkCreation(ImNodesEditorContext& editor, const int hovered_pin_idx) +{ + editor.ClickInteraction.Type = ImNodesClickInteractionType_LinkCreation; + editor.ClickInteraction.LinkCreation.StartPinIdx = hovered_pin_idx; + editor.ClickInteraction.LinkCreation.EndPinIdx.Reset(); + editor.ClickInteraction.LinkCreation.Type = ImNodesLinkCreationType_Standard; + GImNodes->ImNodesUIState |= ImNodesUIState_LinkStarted; +} + +void BeginLinkInteraction( + ImNodesEditorContext& editor, + const int link_idx, + const ImOptionalIndex pin_idx = ImOptionalIndex()) +{ + // Check if we are clicking the link with the modifier pressed. + // This will in a link detach via clicking. + + const bool modifier_pressed = GImNodes->Io.LinkDetachWithModifierClick.Modifier == NULL + ? false + : *GImNodes->Io.LinkDetachWithModifierClick.Modifier; + + if (modifier_pressed) + { + const ImLinkData& link = editor.Links.Pool[link_idx]; + const ImPinData& start_pin = editor.Pins.Pool[link.StartPinIdx]; + const ImPinData& end_pin = editor.Pins.Pool[link.EndPinIdx]; + const ImVec2& mouse_pos = GImNodes->MousePos; + const float dist_to_start = ImLengthSqr(start_pin.Pos - mouse_pos); + const float dist_to_end = ImLengthSqr(end_pin.Pos - mouse_pos); + const int closest_pin_idx = dist_to_start < dist_to_end ? link.StartPinIdx : link.EndPinIdx; + + editor.ClickInteraction.Type = ImNodesClickInteractionType_LinkCreation; + BeginLinkDetach(editor, link_idx, closest_pin_idx); + editor.ClickInteraction.LinkCreation.Type = ImNodesLinkCreationType_FromDetach; + } + else + { + if (pin_idx.HasValue()) + { + const int hovered_pin_flags = editor.Pins.Pool[pin_idx.Value()].Flags; + + // Check the 'click and drag to detach' case. + if (hovered_pin_flags & ImNodesAttributeFlags_EnableLinkDetachWithDragClick) + { + BeginLinkDetach(editor, link_idx, pin_idx.Value()); + editor.ClickInteraction.LinkCreation.Type = ImNodesLinkCreationType_FromDetach; + } + else + { + BeginLinkCreation(editor, pin_idx.Value()); + } + } + else + { + BeginLinkSelection(editor, link_idx); + } + } +} + +static inline bool IsMiniMapHovered(); + +void BeginCanvasInteraction(ImNodesEditorContext& editor) +{ + const bool any_ui_element_hovered = + GImNodes->HoveredNodeIdx.HasValue() || GImNodes->HoveredLinkIdx.HasValue() || + GImNodes->HoveredPinIdx.HasValue() || ImGui::IsAnyItemHovered(); + + const bool mouse_not_in_canvas = !MouseInCanvas(); + + if (editor.ClickInteraction.Type != ImNodesClickInteractionType_None || + any_ui_element_hovered || mouse_not_in_canvas) + { + return; + } + + const bool started_panning = GImNodes->AltMouseClicked; + + if (started_panning) + { + editor.ClickInteraction.Type = ImNodesClickInteractionType_Panning; + } + else if (GImNodes->LeftMouseClicked) + { + editor.ClickInteraction.Type = ImNodesClickInteractionType_BoxSelection; + editor.ClickInteraction.BoxSelector.Rect.Min = + ScreenSpaceToGridSpace(editor, GImNodes->MousePos); + } +} + +void BoxSelectorUpdateSelection(ImNodesEditorContext& editor, ImRect box_rect) +{ + // Invert box selector coordinates as needed + + if (box_rect.Min.x > box_rect.Max.x) + { + ImSwap(box_rect.Min.x, box_rect.Max.x); + } + + if (box_rect.Min.y > box_rect.Max.y) + { + ImSwap(box_rect.Min.y, box_rect.Max.y); + } + + // Update node selection + + editor.SelectedNodeIndices.clear(); + + // Test for overlap against node rectangles + + for (int node_idx = 0; node_idx < editor.Nodes.Pool.size(); ++node_idx) + { + if (editor.Nodes.InUse[node_idx]) + { + ImNodeData& node = editor.Nodes.Pool[node_idx]; + if (box_rect.Overlaps(node.Rect)) + { + editor.SelectedNodeIndices.push_back(node_idx); + } + } + } + + // Update link selection + + editor.SelectedLinkIndices.clear(); + + // Test for overlap against links + + for (int link_idx = 0; link_idx < editor.Links.Pool.size(); ++link_idx) + { + if (editor.Links.InUse[link_idx]) + { + const ImLinkData& link = editor.Links.Pool[link_idx]; + + const ImPinData& pin_start = editor.Pins.Pool[link.StartPinIdx]; + const ImPinData& pin_end = editor.Pins.Pool[link.EndPinIdx]; + const ImRect& node_start_rect = editor.Nodes.Pool[pin_start.ParentNodeIdx].Rect; + const ImRect& node_end_rect = editor.Nodes.Pool[pin_end.ParentNodeIdx].Rect; + + const ImVec2 start = GetScreenSpacePinCoordinates( + node_start_rect, pin_start.AttributeRect, pin_start.Type); + const ImVec2 end = + GetScreenSpacePinCoordinates(node_end_rect, pin_end.AttributeRect, pin_end.Type); + + // Test + if (RectangleOverlapsLink(box_rect, start, end, pin_start.Type)) + { + editor.SelectedLinkIndices.push_back(link_idx); + } + } + } +} + +void TranslateSelectedNodes(ImNodesEditorContext& editor) +{ + if (GImNodes->LeftMouseDragging) + { + const ImGuiIO& io = ImGui::GetIO(); + for (int i = 0; i < editor.SelectedNodeIndices.size(); ++i) + { + const int node_idx = editor.SelectedNodeIndices[i]; + ImNodeData& node = editor.Nodes.Pool[node_idx]; + if (node.Draggable) + { + node.Origin += io.MouseDelta - editor.AutoPanningDelta; + } + } + } +} + +struct LinkPredicate +{ + bool operator()(const ImLinkData& lhs, const ImLinkData& rhs) const + { + // Do a unique compare by sorting the pins' addresses. + // This catches duplicate links, whether they are in the + // same direction or not. + // Sorting by pin index should have the uniqueness guarantees as sorting + // by id -- each unique id will get one slot in the link pool array. + + int lhs_start = lhs.StartPinIdx; + int lhs_end = lhs.EndPinIdx; + int rhs_start = rhs.StartPinIdx; + int rhs_end = rhs.EndPinIdx; + + if (lhs_start > lhs_end) + { + ImSwap(lhs_start, lhs_end); + } + + if (rhs_start > rhs_end) + { + ImSwap(rhs_start, rhs_end); + } + + return lhs_start == rhs_start && lhs_end == rhs_end; + } +}; + +ImOptionalIndex FindDuplicateLink( + const ImNodesEditorContext& editor, + const int start_pin_idx, + const int end_pin_idx) +{ + ImLinkData test_link(0); + test_link.StartPinIdx = start_pin_idx; + test_link.EndPinIdx = end_pin_idx; + for (int link_idx = 0; link_idx < editor.Links.Pool.size(); ++link_idx) + { + const ImLinkData& link = editor.Links.Pool[link_idx]; + if (LinkPredicate()(test_link, link) && editor.Links.InUse[link_idx]) + { + return ImOptionalIndex(link_idx); + } + } + + return ImOptionalIndex(); +} + +bool ShouldLinkSnapToPin( + const ImNodesEditorContext& editor, + const ImPinData& start_pin, + const int hovered_pin_idx, + const ImOptionalIndex duplicate_link) +{ + const ImPinData& end_pin = editor.Pins.Pool[hovered_pin_idx]; + + // The end pin must be in a different node + if (start_pin.ParentNodeIdx == end_pin.ParentNodeIdx) + { + return false; + } + + // The end pin must be of a different type + if (start_pin.Type == end_pin.Type) + { + return false; + } + + // The link to be created must not be a duplicate, unless it is the link which was created on + // snap. In that case we want to snap, since we want it to appear visually as if the created + // link remains snapped to the pin. + if (duplicate_link.HasValue() && !(duplicate_link == GImNodes->SnapLinkIdx)) + { + return false; + } + + return true; +} + +void ClickInteractionUpdate(ImNodesEditorContext& editor) +{ + switch (editor.ClickInteraction.Type) + { + case ImNodesClickInteractionType_BoxSelection: + { + editor.ClickInteraction.BoxSelector.Rect.Max = + ScreenSpaceToGridSpace(editor, GImNodes->MousePos); + + ImRect box_rect = editor.ClickInteraction.BoxSelector.Rect; + box_rect.Min = GridSpaceToScreenSpace(editor, box_rect.Min); + box_rect.Max = GridSpaceToScreenSpace(editor, box_rect.Max); + + BoxSelectorUpdateSelection(editor, box_rect); + + const ImU32 box_selector_color = GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_BoxSelector]; + const ImU32 box_selector_outline = GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_BoxSelectorOutline]; + GImNodes->CanvasDrawList->AddRectFilled(box_rect.Min, box_rect.Max, box_selector_color); + GImNodes->CanvasDrawList->AddRect(box_rect.Min, box_rect.Max, box_selector_outline); + + if (GImNodes->LeftMouseReleased) + { + ImVector& depth_stack = editor.NodeDepthOrder; + const ImVector& selected_idxs = editor.SelectedNodeIndices; + + // Bump the selected node indices, in order, to the top of the depth stack. + // NOTE: this algorithm has worst case time complexity of O(N^2), if the node selection + // is ~ N (due to selected_idxs.contains()). + + if ((selected_idxs.Size > 0) && (selected_idxs.Size < depth_stack.Size)) + { + int num_moved = 0; // The number of indices moved. Stop after selected_idxs.Size + for (int i = 0; i < depth_stack.Size - selected_idxs.Size; ++i) + { + for (int node_idx = depth_stack[i]; selected_idxs.contains(node_idx); + node_idx = depth_stack[i]) + { + depth_stack.erase(depth_stack.begin() + static_cast(i)); + depth_stack.push_back(node_idx); + ++num_moved; + } + + if (num_moved == selected_idxs.Size) + { + break; + } + } + } + + editor.ClickInteraction.Type = ImNodesClickInteractionType_None; + } + } + break; + case ImNodesClickInteractionType_Node: + { + TranslateSelectedNodes(editor); + + if (GImNodes->LeftMouseReleased) + { + editor.ClickInteraction.Type = ImNodesClickInteractionType_None; + } + } + break; + case ImNodesClickInteractionType_Link: + { + if (GImNodes->LeftMouseReleased) + { + editor.ClickInteraction.Type = ImNodesClickInteractionType_None; + } + } + break; + case ImNodesClickInteractionType_LinkCreation: + { + const ImPinData& start_pin = + editor.Pins.Pool[editor.ClickInteraction.LinkCreation.StartPinIdx]; + + const ImOptionalIndex maybe_duplicate_link_idx = + GImNodes->HoveredPinIdx.HasValue() + ? FindDuplicateLink( + editor, + editor.ClickInteraction.LinkCreation.StartPinIdx, + GImNodes->HoveredPinIdx.Value()) + : ImOptionalIndex(); + + const bool should_snap = + GImNodes->HoveredPinIdx.HasValue() && + ShouldLinkSnapToPin( + editor, start_pin, GImNodes->HoveredPinIdx.Value(), maybe_duplicate_link_idx); + + // If we created on snap and the hovered pin is empty or changed, then we need signal that + // the link's state has changed. + const bool snapping_pin_changed = + editor.ClickInteraction.LinkCreation.EndPinIdx.HasValue() && + !(GImNodes->HoveredPinIdx == editor.ClickInteraction.LinkCreation.EndPinIdx); + + // Detach the link that was created by this link event if it's no longer in snap range + if (snapping_pin_changed && GImNodes->SnapLinkIdx.HasValue()) + { + BeginLinkDetach( + editor, + GImNodes->SnapLinkIdx.Value(), + editor.ClickInteraction.LinkCreation.EndPinIdx.Value()); + } + + const ImVec2 start_pos = GetScreenSpacePinCoordinates(editor, start_pin); + // If we are within the hover radius of a receiving pin, snap the link + // endpoint to it + const ImVec2 end_pos = should_snap + ? GetScreenSpacePinCoordinates( + editor, editor.Pins.Pool[GImNodes->HoveredPinIdx.Value()]) + : GImNodes->MousePos; + + const CubicBezier cubic_bezier = GetCubicBezier( + start_pos, end_pos, start_pin.Type, GImNodes->Style.LinkLineSegmentsPerLength); +#if IMGUI_VERSION_NUM < 18000 + GImNodes->CanvasDrawList->AddBezierCurve( +#else + GImNodes->CanvasDrawList->AddBezierCubic( +#endif + cubic_bezier.P0, + cubic_bezier.P1, + cubic_bezier.P2, + cubic_bezier.P3, + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_Link], + GImNodes->Style.LinkThickness, + cubic_bezier.NumSegments); + + const bool link_creation_on_snap = + GImNodes->HoveredPinIdx.HasValue() && + (editor.Pins.Pool[GImNodes->HoveredPinIdx.Value()].Flags & + ImNodesAttributeFlags_EnableLinkCreationOnSnap); + + if (!should_snap) + { + editor.ClickInteraction.LinkCreation.EndPinIdx.Reset(); + } + + const bool create_link = + should_snap && (GImNodes->LeftMouseReleased || link_creation_on_snap); + + if (create_link && !maybe_duplicate_link_idx.HasValue()) + { + // Avoid send OnLinkCreated() events every frame if the snap link is not saved + // (only applies for EnableLinkCreationOnSnap) + if (!GImNodes->LeftMouseReleased && + editor.ClickInteraction.LinkCreation.EndPinIdx == GImNodes->HoveredPinIdx) + { + break; + } + + GImNodes->ImNodesUIState |= ImNodesUIState_LinkCreated; + editor.ClickInteraction.LinkCreation.EndPinIdx = GImNodes->HoveredPinIdx.Value(); + } + + if (GImNodes->LeftMouseReleased) + { + editor.ClickInteraction.Type = ImNodesClickInteractionType_None; + if (!create_link) + { + GImNodes->ImNodesUIState |= ImNodesUIState_LinkDropped; + } + } + } + break; + case ImNodesClickInteractionType_Panning: + { + const bool dragging = GImNodes->AltMouseDragging; + + if (dragging) + { + editor.Panning += ImGui::GetIO().MouseDelta; + } + else + { + editor.ClickInteraction.Type = ImNodesClickInteractionType_None; + } + } + break; + case ImNodesClickInteractionType_ImGuiItem: + { + if (GImNodes->LeftMouseReleased) + { + editor.ClickInteraction.Type = ImNodesClickInteractionType_None; + } + } + case ImNodesClickInteractionType_None: + break; + default: + assert(!"Unreachable code!"); + break; + } +} + +void ResolveOccludedPins(const ImNodesEditorContext& editor, ImVector& occluded_pin_indices) +{ + const ImVector& depth_stack = editor.NodeDepthOrder; + + occluded_pin_indices.resize(0); + + if (depth_stack.Size < 2) + { + return; + } + + // For each node in the depth stack + for (int depth_idx = 0; depth_idx < (depth_stack.Size - 1); ++depth_idx) + { + const ImNodeData& node_below = editor.Nodes.Pool[depth_stack[depth_idx]]; + + // Iterate over the rest of the depth stack to find nodes overlapping the pins + for (int next_depth_idx = depth_idx + 1; next_depth_idx < depth_stack.Size; + ++next_depth_idx) + { + const ImRect& rect_above = editor.Nodes.Pool[depth_stack[next_depth_idx]].Rect; + + // Iterate over each pin + for (int idx = 0; idx < node_below.PinIndices.Size; ++idx) + { + const int pin_idx = node_below.PinIndices[idx]; + const ImVec2& pin_pos = editor.Pins.Pool[pin_idx].Pos; + + if (rect_above.Contains(pin_pos)) + { + occluded_pin_indices.push_back(pin_idx); + } + } + } + } +} + +ImOptionalIndex ResolveHoveredPin( + const ImObjectPool& pins, + const ImVector& occluded_pin_indices) +{ + float smallest_distance = FLT_MAX; + ImOptionalIndex pin_idx_with_smallest_distance; + + const float hover_radius_sqr = GImNodes->Style.PinHoverRadius * GImNodes->Style.PinHoverRadius; + + for (int idx = 0; idx < pins.Pool.Size; ++idx) + { + if (!pins.InUse[idx]) + { + continue; + } + + if (occluded_pin_indices.contains(idx)) + { + continue; + } + + const ImVec2& pin_pos = pins.Pool[idx].Pos; + const float distance_sqr = ImLengthSqr(pin_pos - GImNodes->MousePos); + + // TODO: GImNodes->Style.PinHoverRadius needs to be copied into pin data and the pin-local + // value used here. This is no longer called in BeginAttribute/EndAttribute scope and the + // detected pin might have a different hover radius than what the user had when calling + // BeginAttribute/EndAttribute. + if (distance_sqr < hover_radius_sqr && distance_sqr < smallest_distance) + { + smallest_distance = distance_sqr; + pin_idx_with_smallest_distance = idx; + } + } + + return pin_idx_with_smallest_distance; +} + +ImOptionalIndex ResolveHoveredNode(const ImVector& depth_stack) +{ + if (GImNodes->NodeIndicesOverlappingWithMouse.size() == 0) + { + return ImOptionalIndex(); + } + + if (GImNodes->NodeIndicesOverlappingWithMouse.size() == 1) + { + return ImOptionalIndex(GImNodes->NodeIndicesOverlappingWithMouse[0]); + } + + int largest_depth_idx = -1; + int node_idx_on_top = -1; + + for (int i = 0; i < GImNodes->NodeIndicesOverlappingWithMouse.size(); ++i) + { + const int node_idx = GImNodes->NodeIndicesOverlappingWithMouse[i]; + for (int depth_idx = 0; depth_idx < depth_stack.size(); ++depth_idx) + { + if (depth_stack[depth_idx] == node_idx && (depth_idx > largest_depth_idx)) + { + largest_depth_idx = depth_idx; + node_idx_on_top = node_idx; + } + } + } + + assert(node_idx_on_top != -1); + return ImOptionalIndex(node_idx_on_top); +} + +ImOptionalIndex ResolveHoveredLink( + const ImObjectPool& links, + const ImObjectPool& pins) +{ + float smallest_distance = FLT_MAX; + ImOptionalIndex link_idx_with_smallest_distance; + + // There are two ways a link can be detected as "hovered". + // 1. The link is within hover distance to the mouse. The closest such link is selected as being + // hovered over. + // 2. If the link is connected to the currently hovered pin. + // + // The latter is a requirement for link detaching with drag click to work, as both a link and + // pin are required to be hovered over for the feature to work. + + for (int idx = 0; idx < links.Pool.Size; ++idx) + { + if (!links.InUse[idx]) + { + continue; + } + + const ImLinkData& link = links.Pool[idx]; + const ImPinData& start_pin = pins.Pool[link.StartPinIdx]; + const ImPinData& end_pin = pins.Pool[link.EndPinIdx]; + + // If there is a hovered pin links can only be considered hovered if they use that pin + if (GImNodes->HoveredPinIdx.HasValue()) + { + if (GImNodes->HoveredPinIdx == link.StartPinIdx || + GImNodes->HoveredPinIdx == link.EndPinIdx) + { + return idx; + } + continue; + } + + // TODO: the calculated CubicBeziers could be cached since we generate them again when + // rendering the links + + const CubicBezier cubic_bezier = GetCubicBezier( + start_pin.Pos, end_pin.Pos, start_pin.Type, GImNodes->Style.LinkLineSegmentsPerLength); + + // The distance test + { + const ImRect link_rect = GetContainingRectForCubicBezier(cubic_bezier); + + // First, do a simple bounding box test against the box containing the link + // to see whether calculating the distance to the link is worth doing. + if (link_rect.Contains(GImNodes->MousePos)) + { + const float distance = GetDistanceToCubicBezier( + GImNodes->MousePos, cubic_bezier, cubic_bezier.NumSegments); + + // TODO: GImNodes->Style.LinkHoverDistance could be also copied into ImLinkData, + // since we're not calling this function in the same scope as ImNodes::Link(). The + // rendered/detected link might have a different hover distance than what the user + // had specified when calling Link() + if (distance < GImNodes->Style.LinkHoverDistance && distance < smallest_distance) + { + smallest_distance = distance; + link_idx_with_smallest_distance = idx; + } + } + } + } + + return link_idx_with_smallest_distance; +} + +// [SECTION] render helpers + +inline ImRect GetItemRect() { return ImRect(ImGui::GetItemRectMin(), ImGui::GetItemRectMax()); } + +inline ImVec2 GetNodeTitleBarOrigin(const ImNodeData& node) +{ + return node.Origin + node.LayoutStyle.Padding; +} + +inline ImVec2 GetNodeContentOrigin(const ImNodeData& node) +{ + const ImVec2 title_bar_height = + ImVec2(0.f, node.TitleBarContentRect.GetHeight() + 2.0f * node.LayoutStyle.Padding.y); + return node.Origin + title_bar_height + node.LayoutStyle.Padding; +} + +inline ImRect GetNodeTitleRect(const ImNodeData& node) +{ + ImRect expanded_title_rect = node.TitleBarContentRect; + expanded_title_rect.Expand(node.LayoutStyle.Padding); + + return ImRect( + expanded_title_rect.Min, + expanded_title_rect.Min + ImVec2(node.Rect.GetWidth(), 0.f) + + ImVec2(0.f, expanded_title_rect.GetHeight())); +} + +void DrawGrid(ImNodesEditorContext& editor, const ImVec2& canvas_size) +{ + const ImVec2 offset = editor.Panning; + + for (float x = fmodf(offset.x, GImNodes->Style.GridSpacing); x < canvas_size.x; + x += GImNodes->Style.GridSpacing) + { + GImNodes->CanvasDrawList->AddLine( + EditorSpaceToScreenSpace(ImVec2(x, 0.0f)), + EditorSpaceToScreenSpace(ImVec2(x, canvas_size.y)), + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_GridLine]); + } + + for (float y = fmodf(offset.y, GImNodes->Style.GridSpacing); y < canvas_size.y; + y += GImNodes->Style.GridSpacing) + { + GImNodes->CanvasDrawList->AddLine( + EditorSpaceToScreenSpace(ImVec2(0.0f, y)), + EditorSpaceToScreenSpace(ImVec2(canvas_size.x, y)), + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_GridLine]); + } +} + +struct QuadOffsets +{ + ImVec2 TopLeft, BottomLeft, BottomRight, TopRight; +}; + +QuadOffsets CalculateQuadOffsets(const float side_length) +{ + const float half_side = 0.5f * side_length; + + QuadOffsets offset; + + offset.TopLeft = ImVec2(-half_side, half_side); + offset.BottomLeft = ImVec2(-half_side, -half_side); + offset.BottomRight = ImVec2(half_side, -half_side); + offset.TopRight = ImVec2(half_side, half_side); + + return offset; +} + +struct TriangleOffsets +{ + ImVec2 TopLeft, BottomLeft, Right; +}; + +TriangleOffsets CalculateTriangleOffsets(const float side_length) +{ + // Calculates the Vec2 offsets from an equilateral triangle's midpoint to + // its vertices. Here is how the left_offset and right_offset are + // calculated. + // + // For an equilateral triangle of side length s, the + // triangle's height, h, is h = s * sqrt(3) / 2. + // + // The length from the base to the midpoint is (1 / 3) * h. The length from + // the midpoint to the triangle vertex is (2 / 3) * h. + const float sqrt_3 = sqrtf(3.0f); + const float left_offset = -0.1666666666667f * sqrt_3 * side_length; + const float right_offset = 0.333333333333f * sqrt_3 * side_length; + const float vertical_offset = 0.5f * side_length; + + TriangleOffsets offset; + offset.TopLeft = ImVec2(left_offset, vertical_offset); + offset.BottomLeft = ImVec2(left_offset, -vertical_offset); + offset.Right = ImVec2(right_offset, 0.f); + + return offset; +} + +void DrawPinShape(const ImVec2& pin_pos, const ImPinData& pin, const ImU32 pin_color) +{ + static const int CIRCLE_NUM_SEGMENTS = 8; + + switch (pin.Shape) + { + case ImNodesPinShape_Circle: + { + GImNodes->CanvasDrawList->AddCircle( + pin_pos, + GImNodes->Style.PinCircleRadius, + pin_color, + CIRCLE_NUM_SEGMENTS, + GImNodes->Style.PinLineThickness); + } + break; + case ImNodesPinShape_CircleFilled: + { + GImNodes->CanvasDrawList->AddCircleFilled( + pin_pos, GImNodes->Style.PinCircleRadius, pin_color, CIRCLE_NUM_SEGMENTS); + } + break; + case ImNodesPinShape_Quad: + { + const QuadOffsets offset = CalculateQuadOffsets(GImNodes->Style.PinQuadSideLength); + GImNodes->CanvasDrawList->AddQuad( + pin_pos + offset.TopLeft, + pin_pos + offset.BottomLeft, + pin_pos + offset.BottomRight, + pin_pos + offset.TopRight, + pin_color, + GImNodes->Style.PinLineThickness); + } + break; + case ImNodesPinShape_QuadFilled: + { + const QuadOffsets offset = CalculateQuadOffsets(GImNodes->Style.PinQuadSideLength); + GImNodes->CanvasDrawList->AddQuadFilled( + pin_pos + offset.TopLeft, + pin_pos + offset.BottomLeft, + pin_pos + offset.BottomRight, + pin_pos + offset.TopRight, + pin_color); + } + break; + case ImNodesPinShape_Triangle: + { + const TriangleOffsets offset = + CalculateTriangleOffsets(GImNodes->Style.PinTriangleSideLength); + GImNodes->CanvasDrawList->AddTriangle( + pin_pos + offset.TopLeft, + pin_pos + offset.BottomLeft, + pin_pos + offset.Right, + pin_color, + // NOTE: for some weird reason, the line drawn by AddTriangle is + // much thinner than the lines drawn by AddCircle or AddQuad. + // Multiplying the line thickness by two seemed to solve the + // problem at a few different thickness values. + 2.f * GImNodes->Style.PinLineThickness); + } + break; + case ImNodesPinShape_TriangleFilled: + { + const TriangleOffsets offset = + CalculateTriangleOffsets(GImNodes->Style.PinTriangleSideLength); + GImNodes->CanvasDrawList->AddTriangleFilled( + pin_pos + offset.TopLeft, + pin_pos + offset.BottomLeft, + pin_pos + offset.Right, + pin_color); + } + break; + default: + assert(!"Invalid PinShape value!"); + break; + } +} + +void DrawPin(ImNodesEditorContext& editor, const int pin_idx) +{ + ImPinData& pin = editor.Pins.Pool[pin_idx]; + const ImRect& parent_node_rect = editor.Nodes.Pool[pin.ParentNodeIdx].Rect; + + pin.Pos = GetScreenSpacePinCoordinates(parent_node_rect, pin.AttributeRect, pin.Type); + + ImU32 pin_color = pin.ColorStyle.Background; + + if (GImNodes->HoveredPinIdx == pin_idx) + { + pin_color = pin.ColorStyle.Hovered; + } + + DrawPinShape(pin.Pos, pin, pin_color); +} + +void DrawNode(ImNodesEditorContext& editor, const int node_idx) +{ + const ImNodeData& node = editor.Nodes.Pool[node_idx]; + ImGui::SetCursorPos(node.Origin + editor.Panning); + + const bool node_hovered = + GImNodes->HoveredNodeIdx == node_idx && + editor.ClickInteraction.Type != ImNodesClickInteractionType_BoxSelection; + + ImU32 node_background = node.ColorStyle.Background; + ImU32 titlebar_background = node.ColorStyle.Titlebar; + + if (editor.SelectedNodeIndices.contains(node_idx)) + { + node_background = node.ColorStyle.BackgroundSelected; + titlebar_background = node.ColorStyle.TitlebarSelected; + } + else if (node_hovered) + { + node_background = node.ColorStyle.BackgroundHovered; + titlebar_background = node.ColorStyle.TitlebarHovered; + } + + { + // node base + GImNodes->CanvasDrawList->AddRectFilled( + node.Rect.Min, node.Rect.Max, node_background, node.LayoutStyle.CornerRounding); + + // title bar: + if (node.TitleBarContentRect.GetHeight() > 0.f) + { + ImRect title_bar_rect = GetNodeTitleRect(node); + +#if IMGUI_VERSION_NUM < 18200 + GImNodes->CanvasDrawList->AddRectFilled( + title_bar_rect.Min, + title_bar_rect.Max, + titlebar_background, + node.LayoutStyle.CornerRounding, + ImDrawCornerFlags_Top); +#else + GImNodes->CanvasDrawList->AddRectFilled( + title_bar_rect.Min, + title_bar_rect.Max, + titlebar_background, + node.LayoutStyle.CornerRounding, + ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersTop); + +#endif + } + + if ((GImNodes->Style.Flags & ImNodesStyleFlags_NodeOutline) != 0) + { +#if IMGUI_VERSION_NUM < 18200 + GImNodes->CanvasDrawList->AddRect( + node.Rect.Min, + node.Rect.Max, + node.ColorStyle.Outline, + node.LayoutStyle.CornerRounding, + ImDrawCornerFlags_All, + node.LayoutStyle.BorderThickness); +#else + GImNodes->CanvasDrawList->AddRect( + node.Rect.Min, + node.Rect.Max, + node.ColorStyle.Outline, + node.LayoutStyle.CornerRounding, + ImDrawFlags_RoundCornersAll, + node.LayoutStyle.BorderThickness); +#endif + } + } + + for (int i = 0; i < node.PinIndices.size(); ++i) + { + DrawPin(editor, node.PinIndices[i]); + } + + if (node_hovered) + { + GImNodes->HoveredNodeIdx = node_idx; + } +} + +void DrawLink(ImNodesEditorContext& editor, const int link_idx) +{ + const ImLinkData& link = editor.Links.Pool[link_idx]; + const ImPinData& start_pin = editor.Pins.Pool[link.StartPinIdx]; + const ImPinData& end_pin = editor.Pins.Pool[link.EndPinIdx]; + + const CubicBezier cubic_bezier = GetCubicBezier( + start_pin.Pos, end_pin.Pos, start_pin.Type, GImNodes->Style.LinkLineSegmentsPerLength); + + const bool link_hovered = + GImNodes->HoveredLinkIdx == link_idx && + editor.ClickInteraction.Type != ImNodesClickInteractionType_BoxSelection; + + if (link_hovered) + { + GImNodes->HoveredLinkIdx = link_idx; + } + + // It's possible for a link to be deleted in begin_link_interaction. A user + // may detach a link, resulting in the link wire snapping to the mouse + // position. + // + // In other words, skip rendering the link if it was deleted. + if (GImNodes->DeletedLinkIdx == link_idx) + { + return; + } + + ImU32 link_color = link.ColorStyle.Base; + if (editor.SelectedLinkIndices.contains(link_idx)) + { + link_color = link.ColorStyle.Selected; + } + else if (link_hovered) + { + link_color = link.ColorStyle.Hovered; + } + +#if IMGUI_VERSION_NUM < 18000 + GImNodes->CanvasDrawList->AddBezierCurve( +#else + GImNodes->CanvasDrawList->AddBezierCubic( +#endif + cubic_bezier.P0, + cubic_bezier.P1, + cubic_bezier.P2, + cubic_bezier.P3, + link_color, + GImNodes->Style.LinkThickness, + cubic_bezier.NumSegments); +} + +void BeginPinAttribute( + const int id, + const ImNodesAttributeType type, + const ImNodesPinShape shape, + const int node_idx) +{ + // Make sure to call BeginNode() before calling + // BeginAttribute() + assert(GImNodes->CurrentScope == ImNodesScope_Node); + GImNodes->CurrentScope = ImNodesScope_Attribute; + + ImGui::BeginGroup(); + ImGui::PushID(id); + + ImNodesEditorContext& editor = EditorContextGet(); + + GImNodes->CurrentAttributeId = id; + + const int pin_idx = ObjectPoolFindOrCreateIndex(editor.Pins, id); + GImNodes->CurrentPinIdx = pin_idx; + ImPinData& pin = editor.Pins.Pool[pin_idx]; + pin.Id = id; + pin.ParentNodeIdx = node_idx; + pin.Type = type; + pin.Shape = shape; + pin.Flags = GImNodes->CurrentAttributeFlags; + pin.ColorStyle.Background = GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_Pin]; + pin.ColorStyle.Hovered = GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_PinHovered]; +} + +void EndPinAttribute() +{ + assert(GImNodes->CurrentScope == ImNodesScope_Attribute); + GImNodes->CurrentScope = ImNodesScope_Node; + + ImGui::PopID(); + ImGui::EndGroup(); + + if (ImGui::IsItemActive()) + { + GImNodes->ActiveAttribute = true; + GImNodes->ActiveAttributeId = GImNodes->CurrentAttributeId; + } + + ImNodesEditorContext& editor = EditorContextGet(); + ImPinData& pin = editor.Pins.Pool[GImNodes->CurrentPinIdx]; + ImNodeData& node = editor.Nodes.Pool[GImNodes->CurrentNodeIdx]; + pin.AttributeRect = GetItemRect(); + node.PinIndices.push_back(GImNodes->CurrentPinIdx); +} + +void Initialize(ImNodesContext* context) +{ + context->CanvasOriginScreenSpace = ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f); + context->CanvasRectScreenSpace = ImRect(ImVec2(0.f, 0.f), ImVec2(0.f, 0.f)); + context->CurrentScope = ImNodesScope_None; + + context->CurrentPinIdx = INT_MAX; + context->CurrentNodeIdx = INT_MAX; + + context->DefaultEditorCtx = EditorContextCreate(); + EditorContextSet(GImNodes->DefaultEditorCtx); + + context->CurrentAttributeFlags = ImNodesAttributeFlags_None; + context->AttributeFlagStack.push_back(GImNodes->CurrentAttributeFlags); + + StyleColorsDark(); +} + +void Shutdown(ImNodesContext* ctx) { EditorContextFree(ctx->DefaultEditorCtx); } + +// [SECTION] minimap + +static inline bool IsMiniMapActive() +{ + ImNodesEditorContext& editor = EditorContextGet(); + return editor.MiniMapEnabled && editor.MiniMapSizeFraction > 0.0f; +} + +static inline bool IsMiniMapHovered() +{ + ImNodesEditorContext& editor = EditorContextGet(); + return IsMiniMapActive() && + ImGui::IsMouseHoveringRect( + editor.MiniMapRectScreenSpace.Min, editor.MiniMapRectScreenSpace.Max); +} + +static inline void CalcMiniMapLayout() +{ + ImNodesEditorContext& editor = EditorContextGet(); + const ImVec2 offset = GImNodes->Style.MiniMapOffset; + const ImVec2 border = GImNodes->Style.MiniMapPadding; + const ImRect editor_rect = GImNodes->CanvasRectScreenSpace; + + // Compute the size of the mini-map area + ImVec2 mini_map_size; + float mini_map_scaling; + { + const ImVec2 max_size = + ImFloor(editor_rect.GetSize() * editor.MiniMapSizeFraction - border * 2.0f); + const float max_size_aspect_ratio = max_size.x / max_size.y; + const ImVec2 grid_content_size = editor.GridContentBounds.IsInverted() + ? max_size + : ImFloor(editor.GridContentBounds.GetSize()); + const float grid_content_aspect_ratio = grid_content_size.x / grid_content_size.y; + mini_map_size = ImFloor( + grid_content_aspect_ratio > max_size_aspect_ratio + ? ImVec2(max_size.x, max_size.x / grid_content_aspect_ratio) + : ImVec2(max_size.y * grid_content_aspect_ratio, max_size.y)); + mini_map_scaling = mini_map_size.x / grid_content_size.x; + } + + // Compute location of the mini-map + ImVec2 mini_map_pos; + { + ImVec2 align; + + switch (editor.MiniMapLocation) + { + case ImNodesMiniMapLocation_BottomRight: + align.x = 1.0f; + align.y = 1.0f; + break; + case ImNodesMiniMapLocation_BottomLeft: + align.x = 0.0f; + align.y = 1.0f; + break; + case ImNodesMiniMapLocation_TopRight: + align.x = 1.0f; + align.y = 0.0f; + break; + case ImNodesMiniMapLocation_TopLeft: // [[fallthrough]] + default: + align.x = 0.0f; + align.y = 0.0f; + break; + } + + const ImVec2 top_left_pos = editor_rect.Min + offset + border; + const ImVec2 bottom_right_pos = editor_rect.Max - offset - border - mini_map_size; + mini_map_pos = ImFloor(ImLerp(top_left_pos, bottom_right_pos, align)); + } + + editor.MiniMapRectScreenSpace = + ImRect(mini_map_pos - border, mini_map_pos + mini_map_size + border); + editor.MiniMapContentScreenSpace = ImRect(mini_map_pos, mini_map_pos + mini_map_size); + editor.MiniMapScaling = mini_map_scaling; +} + +static void MiniMapDrawNode(ImNodesEditorContext& editor, const int node_idx) +{ + const ImNodeData& node = editor.Nodes.Pool[node_idx]; + + const ImRect node_rect = ScreenSpaceToMiniMapSpace(editor, node.Rect); + + // Round to near whole pixel value for corner-rounding to prevent visual glitches + const float mini_map_node_rounding = + floorf(node.LayoutStyle.CornerRounding * editor.MiniMapScaling); + + ImU32 mini_map_node_background; + + if (editor.ClickInteraction.Type == ImNodesClickInteractionType_None && + ImGui::IsMouseHoveringRect(node_rect.Min, node_rect.Max)) + { + mini_map_node_background = GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_MiniMapNodeBackgroundHovered]; + + // Run user callback when hovering a mini-map node + if (editor.MiniMapNodeHoveringCallback) + { + editor.MiniMapNodeHoveringCallback(node.Id, editor.MiniMapNodeHoveringCallbackUserData); + } + } + else if (editor.SelectedNodeIndices.contains(node_idx)) + { + mini_map_node_background = GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_MiniMapNodeBackgroundSelected]; + } + else + { + mini_map_node_background = GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_MiniMapNodeBackground]; + } + + const ImU32 mini_map_node_outline = GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_MiniMapNodeOutline]; + + GImNodes->CanvasDrawList->AddRectFilled( + node_rect.Min, node_rect.Max, mini_map_node_background, mini_map_node_rounding); + + GImNodes->CanvasDrawList->AddRect( + node_rect.Min, node_rect.Max, mini_map_node_outline, mini_map_node_rounding); +} + +static void MiniMapDrawLink(ImNodesEditorContext& editor, const int link_idx) +{ + const ImLinkData& link = editor.Links.Pool[link_idx]; + const ImPinData& start_pin = editor.Pins.Pool[link.StartPinIdx]; + const ImPinData& end_pin = editor.Pins.Pool[link.EndPinIdx]; + + const CubicBezier cubic_bezier = GetCubicBezier( + ScreenSpaceToMiniMapSpace(editor, start_pin.Pos), + ScreenSpaceToMiniMapSpace(editor, end_pin.Pos), + start_pin.Type, + GImNodes->Style.LinkLineSegmentsPerLength / editor.MiniMapScaling); + + // It's possible for a link to be deleted in begin_link_interaction. A user + // may detach a link, resulting in the link wire snapping to the mouse + // position. + // + // In other words, skip rendering the link if it was deleted. + if (GImNodes->DeletedLinkIdx == link_idx) + { + return; + } + + const ImU32 link_color = + GImNodes->Style.Colors + [editor.SelectedLinkIndices.contains(link_idx) ? ImNodesCol_MiniMapLinkSelected + : ImNodesCol_MiniMapLink]; + +#if IMGUI_VERSION_NUM < 18000 + GImNodes->CanvasDrawList->AddBezierCurve( +#else + GImNodes->CanvasDrawList->AddBezierCubic( +#endif + cubic_bezier.P0, + cubic_bezier.P1, + cubic_bezier.P2, + cubic_bezier.P3, + link_color, + GImNodes->Style.LinkThickness * editor.MiniMapScaling, + cubic_bezier.NumSegments); +} + +static void MiniMapUpdate() +{ + ImNodesEditorContext& editor = EditorContextGet(); + + ImU32 mini_map_background; + + if (IsMiniMapHovered()) + { + mini_map_background = GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_MiniMapBackgroundHovered]; + } + else + { + mini_map_background = GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_MiniMapBackground]; + } + + // Create a child window bellow mini-map, so it blocks all mouse interaction on canvas. + int flags = ImGuiWindowFlags_NoBackground; + ImGui::SetCursorScreenPos(editor.MiniMapRectScreenSpace.Min); + ImGui::BeginChild("minimap", editor.MiniMapRectScreenSpace.GetSize(), false, flags); + + const ImRect& mini_map_rect = editor.MiniMapRectScreenSpace; + + // Draw minimap background and border + GImNodes->CanvasDrawList->AddRectFilled( + mini_map_rect.Min, mini_map_rect.Max, mini_map_background); + + GImNodes->CanvasDrawList->AddRect( + mini_map_rect.Min, mini_map_rect.Max, GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_MiniMapOutline]); + + // Clip draw list items to mini-map rect (after drawing background/outline) + GImNodes->CanvasDrawList->PushClipRect( + mini_map_rect.Min, mini_map_rect.Max, true /* intersect with editor clip-rect */); + + // Draw links first so they appear under nodes, and we can use the same draw channel + for (int link_idx = 0; link_idx < editor.Links.Pool.size(); ++link_idx) + { + if (editor.Links.InUse[link_idx]) + { + MiniMapDrawLink(editor, link_idx); + } + } + + for (int node_idx = 0; node_idx < editor.Nodes.Pool.size(); ++node_idx) + { + if (editor.Nodes.InUse[node_idx]) + { + MiniMapDrawNode(editor, node_idx); + } + } + + // Draw editor canvas rect inside mini-map + { + const ImU32 canvas_color = GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_MiniMapCanvas]; + const ImU32 outline_color = GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_MiniMapCanvasOutline]; + const ImRect rect = ScreenSpaceToMiniMapSpace(editor, GImNodes->CanvasRectScreenSpace); + + GImNodes->CanvasDrawList->AddRectFilled(rect.Min, rect.Max, canvas_color); + GImNodes->CanvasDrawList->AddRect(rect.Min, rect.Max, outline_color); + } + + // Have to pop mini-map clip rect + GImNodes->CanvasDrawList->PopClipRect(); + + bool mini_map_is_hovered = ImGui::IsWindowHovered(); + + ImGui::EndChild(); + + bool center_on_click = mini_map_is_hovered && ImGui::IsMouseDown(ImGuiMouseButton_Left) && + editor.ClickInteraction.Type == ImNodesClickInteractionType_None && + !GImNodes->NodeIdxSubmissionOrder.empty(); + if (center_on_click) + { + ImVec2 target = MiniMapSpaceToGridSpace(editor, ImGui::GetMousePos()); + ImVec2 center = GImNodes->CanvasRectScreenSpace.GetSize() * 0.5f; + editor.Panning = ImFloor(center - target); + } + + // Reset callback info after use + editor.MiniMapNodeHoveringCallback = NULL; + editor.MiniMapNodeHoveringCallbackUserData = NULL; +} + +// [SECTION] selection helpers + +template +void SelectObject(const ImObjectPool& objects, ImVector& selected_indices, const int id) +{ + const int idx = ObjectPoolFind(objects, id); + assert(idx >= 0); + assert(selected_indices.find(idx) == selected_indices.end()); + selected_indices.push_back(idx); +} + +template +void ClearObjectSelection( + const ImObjectPool& objects, + ImVector& selected_indices, + const int id) +{ + const int idx = ObjectPoolFind(objects, id); + assert(idx >= 0); + assert(selected_indices.find(idx) != selected_indices.end()); + selected_indices.find_erase_unsorted(idx); +} + +template +bool IsObjectSelected(const ImObjectPool& objects, ImVector& selected_indices, const int id) +{ + const int idx = ObjectPoolFind(objects, id); + return selected_indices.find(idx) != selected_indices.end(); +} + +} // namespace +} // namespace IMNODES_NAMESPACE + +// [SECTION] API implementation + +ImNodesIO::EmulateThreeButtonMouse::EmulateThreeButtonMouse() : Modifier(NULL) {} + +ImNodesIO::LinkDetachWithModifierClick::LinkDetachWithModifierClick() : Modifier(NULL) {} + +ImNodesIO::ImNodesIO() + : EmulateThreeButtonMouse(), LinkDetachWithModifierClick(), + AltMouseButton(ImGuiMouseButton_Middle), AutoPanningSpeed(1000.0f) +{ +} + +ImNodesStyle::ImNodesStyle() + : GridSpacing(32.f), NodeCornerRounding(4.f), NodePadding(8.f, 8.f), NodeBorderThickness(1.f), + LinkThickness(3.f), LinkLineSegmentsPerLength(0.1f), LinkHoverDistance(10.f), + PinCircleRadius(4.f), PinQuadSideLength(7.f), PinTriangleSideLength(9.5), + PinLineThickness(1.f), PinHoverRadius(10.f), PinOffset(0.f), MiniMapPadding(8.0f, 8.0f), + MiniMapOffset(4.0f, 4.0f), Flags(ImNodesStyleFlags_NodeOutline | ImNodesStyleFlags_GridLines), + Colors() +{ +} + +namespace IMNODES_NAMESPACE +{ +ImNodesContext* CreateContext() +{ + ImNodesContext* ctx = IM_NEW(ImNodesContext)(); + if (GImNodes == NULL) + SetCurrentContext(ctx); + Initialize(ctx); + return ctx; +} + +void DestroyContext(ImNodesContext* ctx) +{ + if (ctx == NULL) + ctx = GImNodes; + Shutdown(ctx); + if (GImNodes == ctx) + SetCurrentContext(NULL); + IM_DELETE(ctx); +} + +ImNodesContext* GetCurrentContext() { return GImNodes; } + +void SetCurrentContext(ImNodesContext* ctx) { GImNodes = ctx; } + +ImNodesEditorContext* EditorContextCreate() +{ + void* mem = ImGui::MemAlloc(sizeof(ImNodesEditorContext)); + new (mem) ImNodesEditorContext(); + return (ImNodesEditorContext*)mem; +} + +void EditorContextFree(ImNodesEditorContext* ctx) +{ + ctx->~ImNodesEditorContext(); + ImGui::MemFree(ctx); +} + +void EditorContextSet(ImNodesEditorContext* ctx) { GImNodes->EditorCtx = ctx; } + +ImVec2 EditorContextGetPanning() +{ + const ImNodesEditorContext& editor = EditorContextGet(); + return editor.Panning; +} + +void EditorContextResetPanning(const ImVec2& pos) +{ + ImNodesEditorContext& editor = EditorContextGet(); + editor.Panning = pos; +} + +void EditorContextMoveToNode(const int node_id) +{ + ImNodesEditorContext& editor = EditorContextGet(); + ImNodeData& node = ObjectPoolFindOrCreateObject(editor.Nodes, node_id); + + editor.Panning.x = -node.Origin.x; + editor.Panning.y = -node.Origin.y; +} + +void SetImGuiContext(ImGuiContext* ctx) { ImGui::SetCurrentContext(ctx); } + +ImNodesIO& GetIO() { return GImNodes->Io; } + +ImNodesStyle& GetStyle() { return GImNodes->Style; } + +void StyleColorsDark() +{ + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_NodeBackground] = IM_COL32(50, 50, 50, 255); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_NodeBackgroundHovered] = IM_COL32(75, 75, 75, 255); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_NodeBackgroundSelected] = IM_COL32(75, 75, 75, 255); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_NodeOutline] = IM_COL32(100, 100, 100, 255); + // title bar colors match ImGui's titlebg colors + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_TitleBar] = IM_COL32(41, 74, 122, 255); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_TitleBarHovered] = IM_COL32(66, 150, 250, 255); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_TitleBarSelected] = IM_COL32(66, 150, 250, 255); + // link colors match ImGui's slider grab colors + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_Link] = IM_COL32(61, 133, 224, 200); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_LinkHovered] = IM_COL32(66, 150, 250, 255); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_LinkSelected] = IM_COL32(66, 150, 250, 255); + // pin colors match ImGui's button colors + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_Pin] = IM_COL32(53, 150, 250, 180); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_PinHovered] = IM_COL32(53, 150, 250, 255); + + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_BoxSelector] = IM_COL32(61, 133, 224, 30); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_BoxSelectorOutline] = IM_COL32(61, 133, 224, 150); + + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_GridBackground] = IM_COL32(40, 40, 50, 200); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_GridLine] = IM_COL32(200, 200, 200, 40); + + // minimap colors + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_MiniMapBackground] = IM_COL32(25, 25, 25, 150); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_MiniMapBackgroundHovered] = IM_COL32(25, 25, 25, 200); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_MiniMapOutline] = IM_COL32(150, 150, 150, 100); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_MiniMapOutlineHovered] = IM_COL32(150, 150, 150, 200); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_MiniMapNodeBackground] = IM_COL32(200, 200, 200, 100); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_MiniMapNodeBackgroundHovered] = IM_COL32(200, 200, 200, 255); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_MiniMapNodeBackgroundSelected] = + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_MiniMapNodeBackgroundHovered]; + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_MiniMapNodeOutline] = IM_COL32(200, 200, 200, 100); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_MiniMapLink] = GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_Link]; + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_MiniMapLinkSelected] = + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_LinkSelected]; + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_MiniMapCanvas] = IM_COL32(200, 200, 200, 25); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_MiniMapCanvasOutline] = IM_COL32(200, 200, 200, 200); +} + +void StyleColorsClassic() +{ + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_NodeBackground] = IM_COL32(50, 50, 50, 255); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_NodeBackgroundHovered] = IM_COL32(75, 75, 75, 255); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_NodeBackgroundSelected] = IM_COL32(75, 75, 75, 255); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_NodeOutline] = IM_COL32(100, 100, 100, 255); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_TitleBar] = IM_COL32(69, 69, 138, 255); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_TitleBarHovered] = IM_COL32(82, 82, 161, 255); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_TitleBarSelected] = IM_COL32(82, 82, 161, 255); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_Link] = IM_COL32(255, 255, 255, 100); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_LinkHovered] = IM_COL32(105, 99, 204, 153); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_LinkSelected] = IM_COL32(105, 99, 204, 153); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_Pin] = IM_COL32(89, 102, 156, 170); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_PinHovered] = IM_COL32(102, 122, 179, 200); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_BoxSelector] = IM_COL32(82, 82, 161, 100); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_BoxSelectorOutline] = IM_COL32(82, 82, 161, 255); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_GridBackground] = IM_COL32(40, 40, 50, 200); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_GridLine] = IM_COL32(200, 200, 200, 40); + + // minimap colors + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_MiniMapBackground] = IM_COL32(25, 25, 25, 100); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_MiniMapBackgroundHovered] = IM_COL32(25, 25, 25, 200); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_MiniMapOutline] = IM_COL32(150, 150, 150, 100); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_MiniMapOutlineHovered] = IM_COL32(150, 150, 150, 200); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_MiniMapNodeBackground] = IM_COL32(200, 200, 200, 100); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_MiniMapNodeBackgroundSelected] = + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_MiniMapNodeBackgroundHovered]; + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_MiniMapNodeBackgroundSelected] = IM_COL32(200, 200, 240, 255); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_MiniMapNodeOutline] = IM_COL32(200, 200, 200, 100); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_MiniMapLink] = GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_Link]; + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_MiniMapLinkSelected] = + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_LinkSelected]; + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_MiniMapCanvas] = IM_COL32(200, 200, 200, 25); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_MiniMapCanvasOutline] = IM_COL32(200, 200, 200, 200); +} + +void StyleColorsLight() +{ + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_NodeBackground] = IM_COL32(240, 240, 240, 255); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_NodeBackgroundHovered] = IM_COL32(240, 240, 240, 255); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_NodeBackgroundSelected] = IM_COL32(240, 240, 240, 255); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_NodeOutline] = IM_COL32(100, 100, 100, 255); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_TitleBar] = IM_COL32(248, 248, 248, 255); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_TitleBarHovered] = IM_COL32(209, 209, 209, 255); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_TitleBarSelected] = IM_COL32(209, 209, 209, 255); + // original imgui values: 66, 150, 250 + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_Link] = IM_COL32(66, 150, 250, 100); + // original imgui values: 117, 138, 204 + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_LinkHovered] = IM_COL32(66, 150, 250, 242); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_LinkSelected] = IM_COL32(66, 150, 250, 242); + // original imgui values: 66, 150, 250 + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_Pin] = IM_COL32(66, 150, 250, 160); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_PinHovered] = IM_COL32(66, 150, 250, 255); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_BoxSelector] = IM_COL32(90, 170, 250, 30); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_BoxSelectorOutline] = IM_COL32(90, 170, 250, 150); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_GridBackground] = IM_COL32(225, 225, 225, 255); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_GridLine] = IM_COL32(180, 180, 180, 100); + + // minimap colors + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_MiniMapBackground] = IM_COL32(25, 25, 25, 100); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_MiniMapBackgroundHovered] = IM_COL32(25, 25, 25, 200); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_MiniMapOutline] = IM_COL32(150, 150, 150, 100); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_MiniMapOutlineHovered] = IM_COL32(150, 150, 150, 200); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_MiniMapNodeBackground] = IM_COL32(200, 200, 200, 100); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_MiniMapNodeBackgroundSelected] = + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_MiniMapNodeBackgroundHovered]; + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_MiniMapNodeBackgroundSelected] = IM_COL32(200, 200, 240, 255); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_MiniMapNodeOutline] = IM_COL32(200, 200, 200, 100); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_MiniMapLink] = GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_Link]; + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_MiniMapLinkSelected] = + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_LinkSelected]; + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_MiniMapCanvas] = IM_COL32(200, 200, 200, 25); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_MiniMapCanvasOutline] = IM_COL32(200, 200, 200, 200); +} + +void BeginNodeEditor() +{ + assert(GImNodes->CurrentScope == ImNodesScope_None); + GImNodes->CurrentScope = ImNodesScope_Editor; + + // Reset state from previous pass + + ImNodesEditorContext& editor = EditorContextGet(); + editor.AutoPanningDelta = ImVec2(0, 0); + editor.GridContentBounds = ImRect(FLT_MAX, FLT_MAX, FLT_MIN, FLT_MIN); + editor.MiniMapEnabled = false; + ObjectPoolReset(editor.Nodes); + ObjectPoolReset(editor.Pins); + ObjectPoolReset(editor.Links); + + GImNodes->HoveredNodeIdx.Reset(); + GImNodes->HoveredLinkIdx.Reset(); + GImNodes->HoveredPinIdx.Reset(); + GImNodes->DeletedLinkIdx.Reset(); + GImNodes->SnapLinkIdx.Reset(); + + GImNodes->NodeIndicesOverlappingWithMouse.clear(); + + GImNodes->ImNodesUIState = ImNodesUIState_None; + + GImNodes->MousePos = ImGui::GetIO().MousePos; + GImNodes->LeftMouseClicked = ImGui::IsMouseClicked(0); + GImNodes->LeftMouseReleased = ImGui::IsMouseReleased(0); + GImNodes->AltMouseClicked = + (GImNodes->Io.EmulateThreeButtonMouse.Modifier != NULL && + *GImNodes->Io.EmulateThreeButtonMouse.Modifier && GImNodes->LeftMouseClicked) || + ImGui::IsMouseClicked(GImNodes->Io.AltMouseButton); + GImNodes->LeftMouseDragging = ImGui::IsMouseDragging(0, 0.0f); + GImNodes->AltMouseDragging = + (GImNodes->Io.EmulateThreeButtonMouse.Modifier != NULL && GImNodes->LeftMouseDragging && + (*GImNodes->Io.EmulateThreeButtonMouse.Modifier)) || + ImGui::IsMouseDragging(GImNodes->Io.AltMouseButton, 0.0f); + GImNodes->AltMouseScrollDelta = ImGui::GetIO().MouseWheel; + + GImNodes->ActiveAttribute = false; + + ImGui::BeginGroup(); + { + ImGui::PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_FramePadding, ImVec2(1.f, 1.f)); + ImGui::PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_WindowPadding, ImVec2(0.f, 0.f)); + ImGui::PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_ChildBg, GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_GridBackground]); + ImGui::BeginChild( + "scrolling_region", + ImVec2(0.f, 0.f), + true, + ImGuiWindowFlags_NoScrollbar | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoMove | + ImGuiWindowFlags_NoScrollWithMouse); + GImNodes->CanvasOriginScreenSpace = ImGui::GetCursorScreenPos(); + + // NOTE: we have to fetch the canvas draw list *after* we call + // BeginChild(), otherwise the ImGui UI elements are going to be + // rendered into the parent window draw list. + DrawListSet(ImGui::GetWindowDrawList()); + + { + const ImVec2 canvas_size = ImGui::GetWindowSize(); + GImNodes->CanvasRectScreenSpace = ImRect( + EditorSpaceToScreenSpace(ImVec2(0.f, 0.f)), EditorSpaceToScreenSpace(canvas_size)); + + if (GImNodes->Style.Flags & ImNodesStyleFlags_GridLines) + { + DrawGrid(editor, canvas_size); + } + } + } +} + +void EndNodeEditor() +{ + assert(GImNodes->CurrentScope == ImNodesScope_Editor); + GImNodes->CurrentScope = ImNodesScope_None; + + ImNodesEditorContext& editor = EditorContextGet(); + + bool no_grid_content = editor.GridContentBounds.IsInverted(); + if (no_grid_content) + { + editor.GridContentBounds = ScreenSpaceToGridSpace(editor, GImNodes->CanvasRectScreenSpace); + } + + // Detect ImGui interaction first, because it blocks interaction with the rest of the UI + + if (GImNodes->LeftMouseClicked && ImGui::IsAnyItemActive()) + { + editor.ClickInteraction.Type = ImNodesClickInteractionType_ImGuiItem; + } + + // Detect which UI element is being hovered over. Detection is done in a hierarchical fashion, + // because a UI element being hovered excludes any other as being hovered over. + + // Don't do hovering detection for nodes/links/pins when interacting with the mini-map, since + // its an *overlay* with its own interaction behavior and must have precedence during mouse + // interaction. + + if ((editor.ClickInteraction.Type == ImNodesClickInteractionType_None || + editor.ClickInteraction.Type == ImNodesClickInteractionType_LinkCreation) && + MouseInCanvas() && !IsMiniMapHovered()) + { + // Pins needs some special care. We need to check the depth stack to see which pins are + // being occluded by other nodes. + ResolveOccludedPins(editor, GImNodes->OccludedPinIndices); + + GImNodes->HoveredPinIdx = ResolveHoveredPin(editor.Pins, GImNodes->OccludedPinIndices); + + if (!GImNodes->HoveredPinIdx.HasValue()) + { + // Resolve which node is actually on top and being hovered using the depth stack. + GImNodes->HoveredNodeIdx = ResolveHoveredNode(editor.NodeDepthOrder); + } + + // We don't check for hovered pins here, because if we want to detach a link by clicking and + // dragging, we need to have both a link and pin hovered. + if (!GImNodes->HoveredNodeIdx.HasValue()) + { + GImNodes->HoveredLinkIdx = ResolveHoveredLink(editor.Links, editor.Pins); + } + } + + for (int node_idx = 0; node_idx < editor.Nodes.Pool.size(); ++node_idx) + { + if (editor.Nodes.InUse[node_idx]) + { + DrawListActivateNodeBackground(node_idx); + DrawNode(editor, node_idx); + } + } + + // In order to render the links underneath the nodes, we want to first select the bottom draw + // channel. + GImNodes->CanvasDrawList->ChannelsSetCurrent(0); + + for (int link_idx = 0; link_idx < editor.Links.Pool.size(); ++link_idx) + { + if (editor.Links.InUse[link_idx]) + { + DrawLink(editor, link_idx); + } + } + + // Render the click interaction UI elements (partial links, box selector) on top of everything + // else. + + DrawListAppendClickInteractionChannel(); + DrawListActivateClickInteractionChannel(); + + if (IsMiniMapActive()) + { + CalcMiniMapLayout(); + MiniMapUpdate(); + } + + // Handle node graph interaction + + if (!IsMiniMapHovered()) + { + if (GImNodes->LeftMouseClicked && GImNodes->HoveredLinkIdx.HasValue()) + { + BeginLinkInteraction(editor, GImNodes->HoveredLinkIdx.Value(), GImNodes->HoveredPinIdx); + } + + else if (GImNodes->LeftMouseClicked && GImNodes->HoveredPinIdx.HasValue()) + { + BeginLinkCreation(editor, GImNodes->HoveredPinIdx.Value()); + } + + else if (GImNodes->LeftMouseClicked && GImNodes->HoveredNodeIdx.HasValue()) + { + BeginNodeSelection(editor, GImNodes->HoveredNodeIdx.Value()); + } + + else if ( + GImNodes->LeftMouseClicked || GImNodes->LeftMouseReleased || + GImNodes->AltMouseClicked || GImNodes->AltMouseScrollDelta != 0.f) + { + BeginCanvasInteraction(editor); + } + + bool should_auto_pan = + editor.ClickInteraction.Type == ImNodesClickInteractionType_BoxSelection || + editor.ClickInteraction.Type == ImNodesClickInteractionType_LinkCreation || + editor.ClickInteraction.Type == ImNodesClickInteractionType_Node; + if (should_auto_pan && !MouseInCanvas()) + { + ImVec2 mouse = ImGui::GetMousePos(); + ImVec2 center = GImNodes->CanvasRectScreenSpace.GetCenter(); + ImVec2 direction = (center - mouse); + direction = direction * ImInvLength(direction, 0.0); + + editor.AutoPanningDelta = + direction * ImGui::GetIO().DeltaTime * GImNodes->Io.AutoPanningSpeed; + editor.Panning += editor.AutoPanningDelta; + } + } + ClickInteractionUpdate(editor); + + // At this point, draw commands have been issued for all nodes (and pins). Update the node pool + // to detect unused node slots and remove those indices from the depth stack before sorting the + // node draw commands by depth. + ObjectPoolUpdate(editor.Nodes); + ObjectPoolUpdate(editor.Pins); + + DrawListSortChannelsByDepth(editor.NodeDepthOrder); + + // After the links have been rendered, the link pool can be updated as well. + ObjectPoolUpdate(editor.Links); + + // Finally, merge the draw channels + GImNodes->CanvasDrawList->ChannelsMerge(); + + // pop style + ImGui::EndChild(); // end scrolling region + ImGui::PopStyleColor(); // pop child window background color + ImGui::PopStyleVar(); // pop window padding + ImGui::PopStyleVar(); // pop frame padding + ImGui::EndGroup(); +} + +void MiniMap( + const float minimap_size_fraction, + const ImNodesMiniMapLocation location, + const ImNodesMiniMapNodeHoveringCallback node_hovering_callback, + const ImNodesMiniMapNodeHoveringCallbackUserData node_hovering_callback_data) +{ + // Check that editor size fraction is sane; must be in the range (0, 1] + assert(minimap_size_fraction > 0.f && minimap_size_fraction <= 1.f); + + // Remember to call before EndNodeEditor + assert(GImNodes->CurrentScope == ImNodesScope_Editor); + + ImNodesEditorContext& editor = EditorContextGet(); + + editor.MiniMapEnabled = true; + editor.MiniMapSizeFraction = minimap_size_fraction; + editor.MiniMapLocation = location; + + // Set node hovering callback information + editor.MiniMapNodeHoveringCallback = node_hovering_callback; + editor.MiniMapNodeHoveringCallbackUserData = node_hovering_callback_data; + + // Actual drawing/updating of the MiniMap is done in EndNodeEditor so that + // mini map is draw over everything and all pin/link positions are updated + // correctly relative to their respective nodes. Hence, we must store some of + // of the state for the mini map in GImNodes for the actual drawing/updating +} + +void BeginNode(const int node_id) +{ + // Remember to call BeginNodeEditor before calling BeginNode + assert(GImNodes->CurrentScope == ImNodesScope_Editor); + GImNodes->CurrentScope = ImNodesScope_Node; + + ImNodesEditorContext& editor = EditorContextGet(); + + const int node_idx = ObjectPoolFindOrCreateIndex(editor.Nodes, node_id); + GImNodes->CurrentNodeIdx = node_idx; + + ImNodeData& node = editor.Nodes.Pool[node_idx]; + node.ColorStyle.Background = GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_NodeBackground]; + node.ColorStyle.BackgroundHovered = GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_NodeBackgroundHovered]; + node.ColorStyle.BackgroundSelected = GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_NodeBackgroundSelected]; + node.ColorStyle.Outline = GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_NodeOutline]; + node.ColorStyle.Titlebar = GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_TitleBar]; + node.ColorStyle.TitlebarHovered = GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_TitleBarHovered]; + node.ColorStyle.TitlebarSelected = GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_TitleBarSelected]; + node.LayoutStyle.CornerRounding = GImNodes->Style.NodeCornerRounding; + node.LayoutStyle.Padding = GImNodes->Style.NodePadding; + node.LayoutStyle.BorderThickness = GImNodes->Style.NodeBorderThickness; + + // ImGui::SetCursorPos sets the cursor position, local to the current widget + // (in this case, the child object started in BeginNodeEditor). Use + // ImGui::SetCursorScreenPos to set the screen space coordinates directly. + ImGui::SetCursorPos(GridSpaceToEditorSpace(editor, GetNodeTitleBarOrigin(node))); + + DrawListAddNode(node_idx); + DrawListActivateCurrentNodeForeground(); + + ImGui::PushID(node.Id); + ImGui::BeginGroup(); +} + +void EndNode() +{ + assert(GImNodes->CurrentScope == ImNodesScope_Node); + GImNodes->CurrentScope = ImNodesScope_Editor; + + ImNodesEditorContext& editor = EditorContextGet(); + + // The node's rectangle depends on the ImGui UI group size. + ImGui::EndGroup(); + ImGui::PopID(); + + ImNodeData& node = editor.Nodes.Pool[GImNodes->CurrentNodeIdx]; + node.Rect = GetItemRect(); + node.Rect.Expand(node.LayoutStyle.Padding); + + editor.GridContentBounds.Add(node.Origin); + editor.GridContentBounds.Add(node.Origin + node.Rect.GetSize()); + + if (node.Rect.Contains(GImNodes->MousePos)) + { + GImNodes->NodeIndicesOverlappingWithMouse.push_back(GImNodes->CurrentNodeIdx); + } +} + +ImVec2 GetNodeDimensions(int node_id) +{ + ImNodesEditorContext& editor = EditorContextGet(); + const int node_idx = ObjectPoolFind(editor.Nodes, node_id); + assert(node_idx != -1); // invalid node_id + const ImNodeData& node = editor.Nodes.Pool[node_idx]; + return node.Rect.GetSize(); +} + +void BeginNodeTitleBar() +{ + assert(GImNodes->CurrentScope == ImNodesScope_Node); + ImGui::BeginGroup(); +} + +void EndNodeTitleBar() +{ + assert(GImNodes->CurrentScope == ImNodesScope_Node); + ImGui::EndGroup(); + + ImNodesEditorContext& editor = EditorContextGet(); + ImNodeData& node = editor.Nodes.Pool[GImNodes->CurrentNodeIdx]; + node.TitleBarContentRect = GetItemRect(); + + ImGui::ItemAdd(GetNodeTitleRect(node), ImGui::GetID("title_bar")); + + ImGui::SetCursorPos(GridSpaceToEditorSpace(editor, GetNodeContentOrigin(node))); +} + +void BeginInputAttribute(const int id, const ImNodesPinShape shape) +{ + BeginPinAttribute(id, ImNodesAttributeType_Input, shape, GImNodes->CurrentNodeIdx); +} + +void EndInputAttribute() { EndPinAttribute(); } + +void BeginOutputAttribute(const int id, const ImNodesPinShape shape) +{ + BeginPinAttribute(id, ImNodesAttributeType_Output, shape, GImNodes->CurrentNodeIdx); +} + +void EndOutputAttribute() { EndPinAttribute(); } + +void BeginStaticAttribute(const int id) +{ + // Make sure to call BeginNode() before calling BeginAttribute() + assert(GImNodes->CurrentScope == ImNodesScope_Node); + GImNodes->CurrentScope = ImNodesScope_Attribute; + + GImNodes->CurrentAttributeId = id; + + ImGui::BeginGroup(); + ImGui::PushID(id); +} + +void EndStaticAttribute() +{ + // Make sure to call BeginNode() before calling BeginAttribute() + assert(GImNodes->CurrentScope == ImNodesScope_Attribute); + GImNodes->CurrentScope = ImNodesScope_Node; + + ImGui::PopID(); + ImGui::EndGroup(); + + if (ImGui::IsItemActive()) + { + GImNodes->ActiveAttribute = true; + GImNodes->ActiveAttributeId = GImNodes->CurrentAttributeId; + } +} + +void PushAttributeFlag(const ImNodesAttributeFlags flag) +{ + GImNodes->CurrentAttributeFlags |= flag; + GImNodes->AttributeFlagStack.push_back(GImNodes->CurrentAttributeFlags); +} + +void PopAttributeFlag() +{ + // PopAttributeFlag called without a matching PushAttributeFlag! + // The bottom value is always the default value, pushed in Initialize(). + assert(GImNodes->AttributeFlagStack.size() > 1); + + GImNodes->AttributeFlagStack.pop_back(); + GImNodes->CurrentAttributeFlags = GImNodes->AttributeFlagStack.back(); +} + +void Link(const int id, const int start_attr_id, const int end_attr_id) +{ + assert(GImNodes->CurrentScope == ImNodesScope_Editor); + + ImNodesEditorContext& editor = EditorContextGet(); + ImLinkData& link = ObjectPoolFindOrCreateObject(editor.Links, id); + link.Id = id; + link.StartPinIdx = ObjectPoolFindOrCreateIndex(editor.Pins, start_attr_id); + link.EndPinIdx = ObjectPoolFindOrCreateIndex(editor.Pins, end_attr_id); + link.ColorStyle.Base = GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_Link]; + link.ColorStyle.Hovered = GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_LinkHovered]; + link.ColorStyle.Selected = GImNodes->Style.Colors[ImNodesCol_LinkSelected]; + + // Check if this link was created by the current link event + if ((editor.ClickInteraction.Type == ImNodesClickInteractionType_LinkCreation && + editor.Pins.Pool[link.EndPinIdx].Flags & ImNodesAttributeFlags_EnableLinkCreationOnSnap && + editor.ClickInteraction.LinkCreation.StartPinIdx == link.StartPinIdx && + editor.ClickInteraction.LinkCreation.EndPinIdx == link.EndPinIdx) || + (editor.ClickInteraction.LinkCreation.StartPinIdx == link.EndPinIdx && + editor.ClickInteraction.LinkCreation.EndPinIdx == link.StartPinIdx)) + { + GImNodes->SnapLinkIdx = ObjectPoolFindOrCreateIndex(editor.Links, id); + } +} + +void PushColorStyle(const ImNodesCol item, unsigned int color) +{ + GImNodes->ColorModifierStack.push_back(ImNodesColElement(GImNodes->Style.Colors[item], item)); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[item] = color; +} + +void PopColorStyle() +{ + assert(GImNodes->ColorModifierStack.size() > 0); + const ImNodesColElement elem = GImNodes->ColorModifierStack.back(); + GImNodes->Style.Colors[elem.Item] = elem.Color; + GImNodes->ColorModifierStack.pop_back(); +} + +struct ImNodesStyleVarInfo +{ + ImGuiDataType Type; + ImU32 Count; + ImU32 Offset; + void* GetVarPtr(ImNodesStyle* style) const { return (void*)((unsigned char*)style + Offset); } +}; + +static const ImNodesStyleVarInfo GStyleVarInfo[] = { + // ImNodesStyleVar_GridSpacing + {ImGuiDataType_Float, 1, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImNodesStyle, GridSpacing)}, + // ImNodesStyleVar_NodeCornerRounding + {ImGuiDataType_Float, 1, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImNodesStyle, NodeCornerRounding)}, + // ImNodesStyleVar_NodePadding + {ImGuiDataType_Float, 2, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImNodesStyle, NodePadding)}, + // ImNodesStyleVar_NodeBorderThickness + {ImGuiDataType_Float, 1, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImNodesStyle, NodeBorderThickness)}, + // ImNodesStyleVar_LinkThickness + {ImGuiDataType_Float, 1, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImNodesStyle, LinkThickness)}, + // ImNodesStyleVar_LinkLineSegmentsPerLength + {ImGuiDataType_Float, 1, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImNodesStyle, LinkLineSegmentsPerLength)}, + // ImNodesStyleVar_LinkHoverDistance + {ImGuiDataType_Float, 1, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImNodesStyle, LinkHoverDistance)}, + // ImNodesStyleVar_PinCircleRadius + {ImGuiDataType_Float, 1, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImNodesStyle, PinCircleRadius)}, + // ImNodesStyleVar_PinQuadSideLength + {ImGuiDataType_Float, 1, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImNodesStyle, PinQuadSideLength)}, + // ImNodesStyleVar_PinTriangleSideLength + {ImGuiDataType_Float, 1, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImNodesStyle, PinTriangleSideLength)}, + // ImNodesStyleVar_PinLineThickness + {ImGuiDataType_Float, 1, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImNodesStyle, PinLineThickness)}, + // ImNodesStyleVar_PinHoverRadius + {ImGuiDataType_Float, 1, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImNodesStyle, PinHoverRadius)}, + // ImNodesStyleVar_PinOffset + {ImGuiDataType_Float, 1, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImNodesStyle, PinOffset)}, + // ImNodesStyleVar_MiniMapPadding + {ImGuiDataType_Float, 2, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImNodesStyle, MiniMapPadding)}, + // ImNodesStyleVar_MiniMapOffset + {ImGuiDataType_Float, 2, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImNodesStyle, MiniMapOffset)}, +}; + +static const ImNodesStyleVarInfo* GetStyleVarInfo(ImNodesStyleVar idx) +{ + IM_ASSERT(idx >= 0 && idx < ImNodesStyleVar_COUNT); + IM_ASSERT(IM_ARRAYSIZE(GStyleVarInfo) == ImNodesStyleVar_COUNT); + return &GStyleVarInfo[idx]; +} + +void PushStyleVar(const ImNodesStyleVar item, const float value) +{ + const ImNodesStyleVarInfo* var_info = GetStyleVarInfo(item); + if (var_info->Type == ImGuiDataType_Float && var_info->Count == 1) + { + float& style_var = *(float*)var_info->GetVarPtr(&GImNodes->Style); + GImNodes->StyleModifierStack.push_back(ImNodesStyleVarElement(item, style_var)); + style_var = value; + return; + } + IM_ASSERT(0 && "Called PushStyleVar() float variant but variable is not a float!"); +} + +void PushStyleVar(const ImNodesStyleVar item, const ImVec2& value) +{ + const ImNodesStyleVarInfo* var_info = GetStyleVarInfo(item); + if (var_info->Type == ImGuiDataType_Float && var_info->Count == 2) + { + ImVec2& style_var = *(ImVec2*)var_info->GetVarPtr(&GImNodes->Style); + GImNodes->StyleModifierStack.push_back(ImNodesStyleVarElement(item, style_var)); + style_var = value; + return; + } + IM_ASSERT(0 && "Called PushStyleVar() ImVec2 variant but variable is not a ImVec2!"); +} + +void PopStyleVar(int count) +{ + while (count > 0) + { + assert(GImNodes->StyleModifierStack.size() > 0); + const ImNodesStyleVarElement style_backup = GImNodes->StyleModifierStack.back(); + GImNodes->StyleModifierStack.pop_back(); + const ImNodesStyleVarInfo* var_info = GetStyleVarInfo(style_backup.Item); + void* style_var = var_info->GetVarPtr(&GImNodes->Style); + if (var_info->Type == ImGuiDataType_Float && var_info->Count == 1) + { + ((float*)style_var)[0] = style_backup.FloatValue[0]; + } + else if (var_info->Type == ImGuiDataType_Float && var_info->Count == 2) + { + ((float*)style_var)[0] = style_backup.FloatValue[0]; + ((float*)style_var)[1] = style_backup.FloatValue[1]; + } + count--; + } +} + +void SetNodeScreenSpacePos(const int node_id, const ImVec2& screen_space_pos) +{ + ImNodesEditorContext& editor = EditorContextGet(); + ImNodeData& node = ObjectPoolFindOrCreateObject(editor.Nodes, node_id); + node.Origin = ScreenSpaceToGridSpace(editor, screen_space_pos); +} + +void SetNodeEditorSpacePos(const int node_id, const ImVec2& editor_space_pos) +{ + ImNodesEditorContext& editor = EditorContextGet(); + ImNodeData& node = ObjectPoolFindOrCreateObject(editor.Nodes, node_id); + node.Origin = EditorSpaceToGridSpace(editor, editor_space_pos); +} + +void SetNodeGridSpacePos(const int node_id, const ImVec2& grid_pos) +{ + ImNodesEditorContext& editor = EditorContextGet(); + ImNodeData& node = ObjectPoolFindOrCreateObject(editor.Nodes, node_id); + node.Origin = grid_pos; +} + +void SetNodeDraggable(const int node_id, const bool draggable) +{ + ImNodesEditorContext& editor = EditorContextGet(); + ImNodeData& node = ObjectPoolFindOrCreateObject(editor.Nodes, node_id); + node.Draggable = draggable; +} + +ImVec2 GetNodeScreenSpacePos(const int node_id) +{ + ImNodesEditorContext& editor = EditorContextGet(); + const int node_idx = ObjectPoolFind(editor.Nodes, node_id); + assert(node_idx != -1); + ImNodeData& node = editor.Nodes.Pool[node_idx]; + return GridSpaceToScreenSpace(editor, node.Origin); +} + +ImVec2 GetNodeEditorSpacePos(const int node_id) +{ + ImNodesEditorContext& editor = EditorContextGet(); + const int node_idx = ObjectPoolFind(editor.Nodes, node_id); + assert(node_idx != -1); + ImNodeData& node = editor.Nodes.Pool[node_idx]; + return GridSpaceToEditorSpace(editor, node.Origin); +} + +ImVec2 GetNodeGridSpacePos(const int node_id) +{ + ImNodesEditorContext& editor = EditorContextGet(); + const int node_idx = ObjectPoolFind(editor.Nodes, node_id); + assert(node_idx != -1); + ImNodeData& node = editor.Nodes.Pool[node_idx]; + return node.Origin; +} + +bool IsEditorHovered() { return MouseInCanvas(); } + +bool IsNodeHovered(int* const node_id) +{ + assert(GImNodes->CurrentScope == ImNodesScope_None); + assert(node_id != NULL); + + const bool is_hovered = GImNodes->HoveredNodeIdx.HasValue(); + if (is_hovered) + { + const ImNodesEditorContext& editor = EditorContextGet(); + *node_id = editor.Nodes.Pool[GImNodes->HoveredNodeIdx.Value()].Id; + } + return is_hovered; +} + +bool IsLinkHovered(int* const link_id) +{ + assert(GImNodes->CurrentScope == ImNodesScope_None); + assert(link_id != NULL); + + const bool is_hovered = GImNodes->HoveredLinkIdx.HasValue(); + if (is_hovered) + { + const ImNodesEditorContext& editor = EditorContextGet(); + *link_id = editor.Links.Pool[GImNodes->HoveredLinkIdx.Value()].Id; + } + return is_hovered; +} + +bool IsPinHovered(int* const attr) +{ + assert(GImNodes->CurrentScope == ImNodesScope_None); + assert(attr != NULL); + + const bool is_hovered = GImNodes->HoveredPinIdx.HasValue(); + if (is_hovered) + { + const ImNodesEditorContext& editor = EditorContextGet(); + *attr = editor.Pins.Pool[GImNodes->HoveredPinIdx.Value()].Id; + } + return is_hovered; +} + +int NumSelectedNodes() +{ + assert(GImNodes->CurrentScope == ImNodesScope_None); + const ImNodesEditorContext& editor = EditorContextGet(); + return editor.SelectedNodeIndices.size(); +} + +int NumSelectedLinks() +{ + assert(GImNodes->CurrentScope == ImNodesScope_None); + const ImNodesEditorContext& editor = EditorContextGet(); + return editor.SelectedLinkIndices.size(); +} + +void GetSelectedNodes(int* node_ids) +{ + assert(node_ids != NULL); + + const ImNodesEditorContext& editor = EditorContextGet(); + for (int i = 0; i < editor.SelectedNodeIndices.size(); ++i) + { + const int node_idx = editor.SelectedNodeIndices[i]; + node_ids[i] = editor.Nodes.Pool[node_idx].Id; + } +} + +void GetSelectedLinks(int* link_ids) +{ + assert(link_ids != NULL); + + const ImNodesEditorContext& editor = EditorContextGet(); + for (int i = 0; i < editor.SelectedLinkIndices.size(); ++i) + { + const int link_idx = editor.SelectedLinkIndices[i]; + link_ids[i] = editor.Links.Pool[link_idx].Id; + } +} + +void ClearNodeSelection() +{ + ImNodesEditorContext& editor = EditorContextGet(); + editor.SelectedNodeIndices.clear(); +} + +void ClearNodeSelection(int node_id) +{ + ImNodesEditorContext& editor = EditorContextGet(); + ClearObjectSelection(editor.Nodes, editor.SelectedNodeIndices, node_id); +} + +void ClearLinkSelection() +{ + ImNodesEditorContext& editor = EditorContextGet(); + editor.SelectedLinkIndices.clear(); +} + +void ClearLinkSelection(int link_id) +{ + ImNodesEditorContext& editor = EditorContextGet(); + ClearObjectSelection(editor.Links, editor.SelectedLinkIndices, link_id); +} + +void SelectNode(int node_id) +{ + ImNodesEditorContext& editor = EditorContextGet(); + SelectObject(editor.Nodes, editor.SelectedNodeIndices, node_id); +} + +void SelectLink(int link_id) +{ + ImNodesEditorContext& editor = EditorContextGet(); + SelectObject(editor.Links, editor.SelectedLinkIndices, link_id); +} + +bool IsNodeSelected(int node_id) +{ + ImNodesEditorContext& editor = EditorContextGet(); + return IsObjectSelected(editor.Nodes, editor.SelectedNodeIndices, node_id); +} + +bool IsLinkSelected(int link_id) +{ + ImNodesEditorContext& editor = EditorContextGet(); + return IsObjectSelected(editor.Links, editor.SelectedLinkIndices, link_id); +} + +bool IsAttributeActive() +{ + assert((GImNodes->CurrentScope & ImNodesScope_Node) != 0); + + if (!GImNodes->ActiveAttribute) + { + return false; + } + + return GImNodes->ActiveAttributeId == GImNodes->CurrentAttributeId; +} + +bool IsAnyAttributeActive(int* const attribute_id) +{ + assert((GImNodes->CurrentScope & (ImNodesScope_Node | ImNodesScope_Attribute)) == 0); + + if (!GImNodes->ActiveAttribute) + { + return false; + } + + if (attribute_id != NULL) + { + *attribute_id = GImNodes->ActiveAttributeId; + } + + return true; +} + +bool IsLinkStarted(int* const started_at_id) +{ + // Call this function after EndNodeEditor()! + assert(GImNodes->CurrentScope == ImNodesScope_None); + assert(started_at_id != NULL); + + const bool is_started = (GImNodes->ImNodesUIState & ImNodesUIState_LinkStarted) != 0; + if (is_started) + { + const ImNodesEditorContext& editor = EditorContextGet(); + const int pin_idx = editor.ClickInteraction.LinkCreation.StartPinIdx; + *started_at_id = editor.Pins.Pool[pin_idx].Id; + } + + return is_started; +} + +bool IsLinkDropped(int* const started_at_id, const bool including_detached_links) +{ + // Call this function after EndNodeEditor()! + assert(GImNodes->CurrentScope == ImNodesScope_None); + + const ImNodesEditorContext& editor = EditorContextGet(); + + const bool link_dropped = + (GImNodes->ImNodesUIState & ImNodesUIState_LinkDropped) != 0 && + (including_detached_links || + editor.ClickInteraction.LinkCreation.Type != ImNodesLinkCreationType_FromDetach); + + if (link_dropped && started_at_id) + { + const int pin_idx = editor.ClickInteraction.LinkCreation.StartPinIdx; + *started_at_id = editor.Pins.Pool[pin_idx].Id; + } + + return link_dropped; +} + +bool IsLinkCreated( + int* const started_at_pin_id, + int* const ended_at_pin_id, + bool* const created_from_snap) +{ + assert(GImNodes->CurrentScope == ImNodesScope_None); + assert(started_at_pin_id != NULL); + assert(ended_at_pin_id != NULL); + + const bool is_created = (GImNodes->ImNodesUIState & ImNodesUIState_LinkCreated) != 0; + + if (is_created) + { + const ImNodesEditorContext& editor = EditorContextGet(); + const int start_idx = editor.ClickInteraction.LinkCreation.StartPinIdx; + const int end_idx = editor.ClickInteraction.LinkCreation.EndPinIdx.Value(); + const ImPinData& start_pin = editor.Pins.Pool[start_idx]; + const ImPinData& end_pin = editor.Pins.Pool[end_idx]; + + if (start_pin.Type == ImNodesAttributeType_Output) + { + *started_at_pin_id = start_pin.Id; + *ended_at_pin_id = end_pin.Id; + } + else + { + *started_at_pin_id = end_pin.Id; + *ended_at_pin_id = start_pin.Id; + } + + if (created_from_snap) + { + *created_from_snap = + editor.ClickInteraction.Type == ImNodesClickInteractionType_LinkCreation; + } + } + + return is_created; +} + +bool IsLinkCreated( + int* started_at_node_id, + int* started_at_pin_id, + int* ended_at_node_id, + int* ended_at_pin_id, + bool* created_from_snap) +{ + assert(GImNodes->CurrentScope == ImNodesScope_None); + assert(started_at_node_id != NULL); + assert(started_at_pin_id != NULL); + assert(ended_at_node_id != NULL); + assert(ended_at_pin_id != NULL); + + const bool is_created = (GImNodes->ImNodesUIState & ImNodesUIState_LinkCreated) != 0; + + if (is_created) + { + const ImNodesEditorContext& editor = EditorContextGet(); + const int start_idx = editor.ClickInteraction.LinkCreation.StartPinIdx; + const int end_idx = editor.ClickInteraction.LinkCreation.EndPinIdx.Value(); + const ImPinData& start_pin = editor.Pins.Pool[start_idx]; + const ImNodeData& start_node = editor.Nodes.Pool[start_pin.ParentNodeIdx]; + const ImPinData& end_pin = editor.Pins.Pool[end_idx]; + const ImNodeData& end_node = editor.Nodes.Pool[end_pin.ParentNodeIdx]; + + if (start_pin.Type == ImNodesAttributeType_Output) + { + *started_at_pin_id = start_pin.Id; + *started_at_node_id = start_node.Id; + *ended_at_pin_id = end_pin.Id; + *ended_at_node_id = end_node.Id; + } + else + { + *started_at_pin_id = end_pin.Id; + *started_at_node_id = end_node.Id; + *ended_at_pin_id = start_pin.Id; + *ended_at_node_id = start_node.Id; + } + + if (created_from_snap) + { + *created_from_snap = + editor.ClickInteraction.Type == ImNodesClickInteractionType_LinkCreation; + } + } + + return is_created; +} + +bool IsLinkDestroyed(int* const link_id) +{ + assert(GImNodes->CurrentScope == ImNodesScope_None); + + const bool link_destroyed = GImNodes->DeletedLinkIdx.HasValue(); + if (link_destroyed) + { + const ImNodesEditorContext& editor = EditorContextGet(); + const int link_idx = GImNodes->DeletedLinkIdx.Value(); + *link_id = editor.Links.Pool[link_idx].Id; + } + + return link_destroyed; +} + +namespace +{ +void NodeLineHandler(ImNodesEditorContext& editor, const char* const line) +{ + int id; + int x, y; + if (sscanf(line, "[node.%i", &id) == 1) + { + const int node_idx = ObjectPoolFindOrCreateIndex(editor.Nodes, id); + GImNodes->CurrentNodeIdx = node_idx; + ImNodeData& node = editor.Nodes.Pool[node_idx]; + node.Id = id; + } + else if (sscanf(line, "origin=%i,%i", &x, &y) == 2) + { + ImNodeData& node = editor.Nodes.Pool[GImNodes->CurrentNodeIdx]; + node.Origin = ImVec2((float)x, (float)y); + } +} + +void EditorLineHandler(ImNodesEditorContext& editor, const char* const line) +{ + (void)sscanf(line, "panning=%f,%f", &editor.Panning.x, &editor.Panning.y); +} +} // namespace + +const char* SaveCurrentEditorStateToIniString(size_t* const data_size) +{ + return SaveEditorStateToIniString(&EditorContextGet(), data_size); +} + +const char* SaveEditorStateToIniString( + const ImNodesEditorContext* const editor_ptr, + size_t* const data_size) +{ + assert(editor_ptr != NULL); + const ImNodesEditorContext& editor = *editor_ptr; + + GImNodes->TextBuffer.clear(); + // TODO: check to make sure that the estimate is the upper bound of element + GImNodes->TextBuffer.reserve(64 * editor.Nodes.Pool.size()); + + GImNodes->TextBuffer.appendf( + "[editor]\npanning=%i,%i\n", (int)editor.Panning.x, (int)editor.Panning.y); + + for (int i = 0; i < editor.Nodes.Pool.size(); i++) + { + if (editor.Nodes.InUse[i]) + { + const ImNodeData& node = editor.Nodes.Pool[i]; + GImNodes->TextBuffer.appendf("\n[node.%d]\n", node.Id); + GImNodes->TextBuffer.appendf("origin=%i,%i\n", (int)node.Origin.x, (int)node.Origin.y); + } + } + + if (data_size != NULL) + { + *data_size = GImNodes->TextBuffer.size(); + } + + return GImNodes->TextBuffer.c_str(); +} + +void LoadCurrentEditorStateFromIniString(const char* const data, const size_t data_size) +{ + LoadEditorStateFromIniString(&EditorContextGet(), data, data_size); +} + +void LoadEditorStateFromIniString( + ImNodesEditorContext* const editor_ptr, + const char* const data, + const size_t data_size) +{ + if (data_size == 0u) + { + return; + } + + ImNodesEditorContext& editor = editor_ptr == NULL ? EditorContextGet() : *editor_ptr; + + char* buf = (char*)ImGui::MemAlloc(data_size + 1); + const char* buf_end = buf + data_size; + memcpy(buf, data, data_size); + buf[data_size] = 0; + + void (*line_handler)(ImNodesEditorContext&, const char*); + line_handler = NULL; + char* line_end = NULL; + for (char* line = buf; line < buf_end; line = line_end + 1) + { + while (*line == '\n' || *line == '\r') + { + line++; + } + line_end = line; + while (line_end < buf_end && *line_end != '\n' && *line_end != '\r') + { + line_end++; + } + line_end[0] = 0; + + if (*line == ';' || *line == '\0') + { + continue; + } + + if (line[0] == '[' && line_end[-1] == ']') + { + line_end[-1] = 0; + if (strncmp(line + 1, "node", 4) == 0) + { + line_handler = NodeLineHandler; + } + else if (strcmp(line + 1, "editor") == 0) + { + line_handler = EditorLineHandler; + } + } + + if (line_handler != NULL) + { + line_handler(editor, line); + } + } + ImGui::MemFree(buf); +} + +void SaveCurrentEditorStateToIniFile(const char* const file_name) +{ + SaveEditorStateToIniFile(&EditorContextGet(), file_name); +} + +void SaveEditorStateToIniFile(const ImNodesEditorContext* const editor, const char* const file_name) +{ + size_t data_size = 0u; + const char* data = SaveEditorStateToIniString(editor, &data_size); + FILE* file = ImFileOpen(file_name, "wt"); + if (!file) + { + return; + } + + fwrite(data, sizeof(char), data_size, file); + fclose(file); +} + +void LoadCurrentEditorStateFromIniFile(const char* const file_name) +{ + LoadEditorStateFromIniFile(&EditorContextGet(), file_name); +} + +void LoadEditorStateFromIniFile(ImNodesEditorContext* const editor, const char* const file_name) +{ + size_t data_size = 0u; + char* file_data = (char*)ImFileLoadToMemory(file_name, "rb", &data_size); + + if (!file_data) + { + return; + } + + LoadEditorStateFromIniString(editor, file_data, data_size); + ImGui::MemFree(file_data); +} +} // namespace IMNODES_NAMESPACE diff --git a/3rdparty/imnodes/imnodes.h b/3rdparty/imnodes/imnodes.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000..b4fe93a --- /dev/null +++ b/3rdparty/imnodes/imnodes.h @@ -0,0 +1,416 @@ +#pragma once + +#include +#include + +#ifdef IMNODES_USER_CONFIG +#include IMNODES_USER_CONFIG +#endif + +#ifndef IMNODES_NAMESPACE +#define IMNODES_NAMESPACE ImNodes +#endif + +typedef int ImNodesCol; // -> enum ImNodesCol_ +typedef int ImNodesStyleVar; // -> enum ImNodesStyleVar_ +typedef int ImNodesStyleFlags; // -> enum ImNodesStyleFlags_ +typedef int ImNodesPinShape; // -> enum ImNodesPinShape_ +typedef int ImNodesAttributeFlags; // -> enum ImNodesAttributeFlags_ +typedef int ImNodesMiniMapLocation; // -> enum ImNodesMiniMapLocation_ + +enum ImNodesCol_ +{ + ImNodesCol_NodeBackground = 0, + ImNodesCol_NodeBackgroundHovered, + ImNodesCol_NodeBackgroundSelected, + ImNodesCol_NodeOutline, + ImNodesCol_TitleBar, + ImNodesCol_TitleBarHovered, + ImNodesCol_TitleBarSelected, + ImNodesCol_Link, + ImNodesCol_LinkHovered, + ImNodesCol_LinkSelected, + ImNodesCol_Pin, + ImNodesCol_PinHovered, + ImNodesCol_BoxSelector, + ImNodesCol_BoxSelectorOutline, + ImNodesCol_GridBackground, + ImNodesCol_GridLine, + ImNodesCol_MiniMapBackground, + ImNodesCol_MiniMapBackgroundHovered, + ImNodesCol_MiniMapOutline, + ImNodesCol_MiniMapOutlineHovered, + ImNodesCol_MiniMapNodeBackground, + ImNodesCol_MiniMapNodeBackgroundHovered, + ImNodesCol_MiniMapNodeBackgroundSelected, + ImNodesCol_MiniMapNodeOutline, + ImNodesCol_MiniMapLink, + ImNodesCol_MiniMapLinkSelected, + ImNodesCol_MiniMapCanvas, + ImNodesCol_MiniMapCanvasOutline, + ImNodesCol_COUNT +}; + +enum ImNodesStyleVar_ +{ + ImNodesStyleVar_GridSpacing = 0, + ImNodesStyleVar_NodeCornerRounding, + ImNodesStyleVar_NodePadding, + ImNodesStyleVar_NodeBorderThickness, + ImNodesStyleVar_LinkThickness, + ImNodesStyleVar_LinkLineSegmentsPerLength, + ImNodesStyleVar_LinkHoverDistance, + ImNodesStyleVar_PinCircleRadius, + ImNodesStyleVar_PinQuadSideLength, + ImNodesStyleVar_PinTriangleSideLength, + ImNodesStyleVar_PinLineThickness, + ImNodesStyleVar_PinHoverRadius, + ImNodesStyleVar_PinOffset, + ImNodesStyleVar_MiniMapPadding, + ImNodesStyleVar_MiniMapOffset, + ImNodesStyleVar_COUNT +}; + +enum ImNodesStyleFlags_ +{ + ImNodesStyleFlags_None = 0, + ImNodesStyleFlags_NodeOutline = 1 << 0, + ImNodesStyleFlags_GridLines = 1 << 2 +}; + +enum ImNodesPinShape_ +{ + ImNodesPinShape_Circle, + ImNodesPinShape_CircleFilled, + ImNodesPinShape_Triangle, + ImNodesPinShape_TriangleFilled, + ImNodesPinShape_Quad, + ImNodesPinShape_QuadFilled +}; + +// This enum controls the way the attribute pins behave. +enum ImNodesAttributeFlags_ +{ + ImNodesAttributeFlags_None = 0, + // Allow detaching a link by left-clicking and dragging the link at a pin it is connected to. + // NOTE: the user has to actually delete the link for this to work. A deleted link can be + // detected by calling IsLinkDestroyed() after EndNodeEditor(). + ImNodesAttributeFlags_EnableLinkDetachWithDragClick = 1 << 0, + // Visual snapping of an in progress link will trigger IsLink Created/Destroyed events. Allows + // for previewing the creation of a link while dragging it across attributes. See here for demo: + // https://github.com/Nelarius/imnodes/issues/41#issuecomment-647132113 NOTE: the user has to + // actually delete the link for this to work. A deleted link can be detected by calling + // IsLinkDestroyed() after EndNodeEditor(). + ImNodesAttributeFlags_EnableLinkCreationOnSnap = 1 << 1 +}; + +struct ImNodesIO +{ + struct EmulateThreeButtonMouse + { + EmulateThreeButtonMouse(); + + // The keyboard modifier to use in combination with mouse left click to pan the editor view. + // Set to NULL by default. To enable this feature, set the modifier to point to a boolean + // indicating the state of a modifier. For example, + // + // ImNodes::GetIO().EmulateThreeButtonMouse.Modifier = &ImGui::GetIO().KeyAlt; + const bool* Modifier; + } EmulateThreeButtonMouse; + + struct LinkDetachWithModifierClick + { + LinkDetachWithModifierClick(); + + // Pointer to a boolean value indicating when the desired modifier is pressed. Set to NULL + // by default. To enable the feature, set the modifier to point to a boolean indicating the + // state of a modifier. For example, + // + // ImNodes::GetIO().LinkDetachWithModifierClick.Modifier = &ImGui::GetIO().KeyCtrl; + // + // Left-clicking a link with this modifier pressed will detach that link. NOTE: the user has + // to actually delete the link for this to work. A deleted link can be detected by calling + // IsLinkDestroyed() after EndNodeEditor(). + const bool* Modifier; + } LinkDetachWithModifierClick; + + // Holding alt mouse button pans the node area, by default middle mouse button will be used + // Set based on ImGuiMouseButton values + int AltMouseButton; + + // Panning speed when dragging an element and mouse is outside the main editor view. + float AutoPanningSpeed; + + ImNodesIO(); +}; + +struct ImNodesStyle +{ + float GridSpacing; + + float NodeCornerRounding; + ImVec2 NodePadding; + float NodeBorderThickness; + + float LinkThickness; + float LinkLineSegmentsPerLength; + float LinkHoverDistance; + + // The following variables control the look and behavior of the pins. The default size of each + // pin shape is balanced to occupy approximately the same surface area on the screen. + + // The circle radius used when the pin shape is either ImNodesPinShape_Circle or + // ImNodesPinShape_CircleFilled. + float PinCircleRadius; + // The quad side length used when the shape is either ImNodesPinShape_Quad or + // ImNodesPinShape_QuadFilled. + float PinQuadSideLength; + // The equilateral triangle side length used when the pin shape is either + // ImNodesPinShape_Triangle or ImNodesPinShape_TriangleFilled. + float PinTriangleSideLength; + // The thickness of the line used when the pin shape is not filled. + float PinLineThickness; + // The radius from the pin's center position inside of which it is detected as being hovered + // over. + float PinHoverRadius; + // Offsets the pins' positions from the edge of the node to the outside of the node. + float PinOffset; + + // Mini-map padding size between mini-map edge and mini-map content. + ImVec2 MiniMapPadding; + // Mini-map offset from the screen side. + ImVec2 MiniMapOffset; + + // By default, ImNodesStyleFlags_NodeOutline and ImNodesStyleFlags_Gridlines are enabled. + ImNodesStyleFlags Flags; + // Set these mid-frame using Push/PopColorStyle. You can index this color array with with a + // ImNodesCol value. + unsigned int Colors[ImNodesCol_COUNT]; + + ImNodesStyle(); +}; + +enum ImNodesMiniMapLocation_ +{ + ImNodesMiniMapLocation_BottomLeft, + ImNodesMiniMapLocation_BottomRight, + ImNodesMiniMapLocation_TopLeft, + ImNodesMiniMapLocation_TopRight, +}; + +struct ImGuiContext; +struct ImVec2; + +struct ImNodesContext; + +// An editor context corresponds to a set of nodes in a single workspace (created with a single +// Begin/EndNodeEditor pair) +// +// By default, the library creates an editor context behind the scenes, so using any of the imnodes +// functions doesn't require you to explicitly create a context. +struct ImNodesEditorContext; + +// Callback type used to specify special behavior when hovering a node in the minimap +#ifndef ImNodesMiniMapNodeHoveringCallback +typedef void (*ImNodesMiniMapNodeHoveringCallback)(int, void*); +#endif + +#ifndef ImNodesMiniMapNodeHoveringCallbackUserData +typedef void* ImNodesMiniMapNodeHoveringCallbackUserData; +#endif + +namespace IMNODES_NAMESPACE +{ +// Call this function if you are compiling imnodes in to a dll, separate from ImGui. Calling this +// function sets the GImGui global variable, which is not shared across dll boundaries. +void SetImGuiContext(ImGuiContext* ctx); + +ImNodesContext* CreateContext(); +void DestroyContext(ImNodesContext* ctx = NULL); // NULL = destroy current context +ImNodesContext* GetCurrentContext(); +void SetCurrentContext(ImNodesContext* ctx); + +ImNodesEditorContext* EditorContextCreate(); +void EditorContextFree(ImNodesEditorContext*); +void EditorContextSet(ImNodesEditorContext*); +ImVec2 EditorContextGetPanning(); +void EditorContextResetPanning(const ImVec2& pos); +void EditorContextMoveToNode(const int node_id); + +ImNodesIO& GetIO(); + +// Returns the global style struct. See the struct declaration for default values. +ImNodesStyle& GetStyle(); +// Style presets matching the dear imgui styles of the same name. +void StyleColorsDark(); // on by default +void StyleColorsClassic(); +void StyleColorsLight(); + +// The top-level function call. Call this before calling BeginNode/EndNode. Calling this function +// will result the node editor grid workspace being rendered. +void BeginNodeEditor(); +void EndNodeEditor(); + +// Add a navigable minimap to the editor; call before EndNodeEditor after all +// nodes and links have been specified +void MiniMap( + const float minimap_size_fraction = 0.2f, + const ImNodesMiniMapLocation location = ImNodesMiniMapLocation_TopLeft, + const ImNodesMiniMapNodeHoveringCallback node_hovering_callback = NULL, + const ImNodesMiniMapNodeHoveringCallbackUserData node_hovering_callback_data = NULL); + +// Use PushColorStyle and PopColorStyle to modify ImNodesStyle::Colors mid-frame. +void PushColorStyle(ImNodesCol item, unsigned int color); +void PopColorStyle(); +void PushStyleVar(ImNodesStyleVar style_item, float value); +void PushStyleVar(ImNodesStyleVar style_item, const ImVec2& value); +void PopStyleVar(int count = 1); + +// id can be any positive or negative integer, but INT_MIN is currently reserved for internal use. +void BeginNode(int id); +void EndNode(); + +ImVec2 GetNodeDimensions(int id); + +// Place your node title bar content (such as the node title, using ImGui::Text) between the +// following function calls. These functions have to be called before adding any attributes, or the +// layout of the node will be incorrect. +void BeginNodeTitleBar(); +void EndNodeTitleBar(); + +// Attributes are ImGui UI elements embedded within the node. Attributes can have pin shapes +// rendered next to them. Links are created between pins. +// +// The activity status of an attribute can be checked via the IsAttributeActive() and +// IsAnyAttributeActive() function calls. This is one easy way of checking for any changes made to +// an attribute's drag float UI, for instance. +// +// Each attribute id must be unique. + +// Create an input attribute block. The pin is rendered on left side. +void BeginInputAttribute(int id, ImNodesPinShape shape = ImNodesPinShape_CircleFilled); +void EndInputAttribute(); +// Create an output attribute block. The pin is rendered on the right side. +void BeginOutputAttribute(int id, ImNodesPinShape shape = ImNodesPinShape_CircleFilled); +void EndOutputAttribute(); +// Create a static attribute block. A static attribute has no pin, and therefore can't be linked to +// anything. However, you can still use IsAttributeActive() and IsAnyAttributeActive() to check for +// attribute activity. +void BeginStaticAttribute(int id); +void EndStaticAttribute(); + +// Push a single AttributeFlags value. By default, only AttributeFlags_None is set. +void PushAttributeFlag(ImNodesAttributeFlags flag); +void PopAttributeFlag(); + +// Render a link between attributes. +// The attributes ids used here must match the ids used in Begin(Input|Output)Attribute function +// calls. The order of start_attr and end_attr doesn't make a difference for rendering the link. +void Link(int id, int start_attribute_id, int end_attribute_id); + +// Enable or disable the ability to click and drag a specific node. +void SetNodeDraggable(int node_id, const bool draggable); + +// The node's position can be expressed in three coordinate systems: +// * screen space coordinates, -- the origin is the upper left corner of the window. +// * editor space coordinates -- the origin is the upper left corner of the node editor window +// * grid space coordinates, -- the origin is the upper left corner of the node editor window, +// translated by the current editor panning vector (see EditorContextGetPanning() and +// EditorContextResetPanning()) + +// Use the following functions to get and set the node's coordinates in these coordinate systems. + +void SetNodeScreenSpacePos(int node_id, const ImVec2& screen_space_pos); +void SetNodeEditorSpacePos(int node_id, const ImVec2& editor_space_pos); +void SetNodeGridSpacePos(int node_id, const ImVec2& grid_pos); + +ImVec2 GetNodeScreenSpacePos(const int node_id); +ImVec2 GetNodeEditorSpacePos(const int node_id); +ImVec2 GetNodeGridSpacePos(const int node_id); + +// Returns true if the current node editor canvas is being hovered over by the mouse, and is not +// blocked by any other windows. +bool IsEditorHovered(); +// The following functions return true if a UI element is being hovered over by the mouse cursor. +// Assigns the id of the UI element being hovered over to the function argument. Use these functions +// after EndNodeEditor() has been called. +bool IsNodeHovered(int* node_id); +bool IsLinkHovered(int* link_id); +bool IsPinHovered(int* attribute_id); + +// Use The following two functions to query the number of selected nodes or links in the current +// editor. Use after calling EndNodeEditor(). +int NumSelectedNodes(); +int NumSelectedLinks(); +// Get the selected node/link ids. The pointer argument should point to an integer array with at +// least as many elements as the respective NumSelectedNodes/NumSelectedLinks function call +// returned. +void GetSelectedNodes(int* node_ids); +void GetSelectedLinks(int* link_ids); +// Clears the list of selected nodes/links. Useful if you want to delete a selected node or link. +void ClearNodeSelection(); +void ClearLinkSelection(); +// Use the following functions to add or remove individual nodes or links from the current editors +// selection. Note that all functions require the id to be an existing valid id for this editor. +// Select-functions has the precondition that the object is currently considered unselected. +// Clear-functions has the precondition that the object is currently considered selected. +// Preconditions listed above can be checked via IsNodeSelected/IsLinkSelected if not already +// known. +void SelectNode(int node_id); +void ClearNodeSelection(int node_id); +bool IsNodeSelected(int node_id); +void SelectLink(int link_id); +void ClearLinkSelection(int link_id); +bool IsLinkSelected(int link_id); + +// Was the previous attribute active? This will continuously return true while the left mouse button +// is being pressed over the UI content of the attribute. +bool IsAttributeActive(); +// Was any attribute active? If so, sets the active attribute id to the output function argument. +bool IsAnyAttributeActive(int* attribute_id = NULL); + +// Use the following functions to query a change of state for an existing link, or new link. Call +// these after EndNodeEditor(). + +// Did the user start dragging a new link from a pin? +bool IsLinkStarted(int* started_at_attribute_id); +// Did the user drop the dragged link before attaching it to a pin? +// There are two different kinds of situations to consider when handling this event: +// 1) a link which is created at a pin and then dropped +// 2) an existing link which is detached from a pin and then dropped +// Use the including_detached_links flag to control whether this function triggers when the user +// detaches a link and drops it. +bool IsLinkDropped(int* started_at_attribute_id = NULL, bool including_detached_links = true); +// Did the user finish creating a new link? +bool IsLinkCreated( + int* started_at_attribute_id, + int* ended_at_attribute_id, + bool* created_from_snap = NULL); +bool IsLinkCreated( + int* started_at_node_id, + int* started_at_attribute_id, + int* ended_at_node_id, + int* ended_at_attribute_id, + bool* created_from_snap = NULL); + +// Was an existing link detached from a pin by the user? The detached link's id is assigned to the +// output argument link_id. +bool IsLinkDestroyed(int* link_id); + +// Use the following functions to write the editor context's state to a string, or directly to a +// file. The editor context is serialized in the INI file format. + +const char* SaveCurrentEditorStateToIniString(size_t* data_size = NULL); +const char* SaveEditorStateToIniString( + const ImNodesEditorContext* editor, + size_t* data_size = NULL); + +void LoadCurrentEditorStateFromIniString(const char* data, size_t data_size); +void LoadEditorStateFromIniString(ImNodesEditorContext* editor, const char* data, size_t data_size); + +void SaveCurrentEditorStateToIniFile(const char* file_name); +void SaveEditorStateToIniFile(const ImNodesEditorContext* editor, const char* file_name); + +void LoadCurrentEditorStateFromIniFile(const char* file_name); +void LoadEditorStateFromIniFile(ImNodesEditorContext* editor, const char* file_name); +} // namespace IMNODES_NAMESPACE diff --git a/3rdparty/imnodes/imnodes_internal.h b/3rdparty/imnodes/imnodes_internal.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000..d77c953 --- /dev/null +++ b/3rdparty/imnodes/imnodes_internal.h @@ -0,0 +1,495 @@ +#pragma once + +#include "imnodes.h" + +#include +#define IMGUI_DEFINE_MATH_OPERATORS +#include + +#include +#include + +// the structure of this file: +// +// [SECTION] internal enums +// [SECTION] internal data structures +// [SECTION] global and editor context structs +// [SECTION] object pool implementation + +struct ImNodesContext; + +extern ImNodesContext* GImNodes; + +// [SECTION] internal enums + +typedef int ImNodesScope; +typedef int ImNodesAttributeType; +typedef int ImNodesUIState; +typedef int ImNodesClickInteractionType; +typedef int ImNodesLinkCreationType; + +enum ImNodesScope_ +{ + ImNodesScope_None = 1, + ImNodesScope_Editor = 1 << 1, + ImNodesScope_Node = 1 << 2, + ImNodesScope_Attribute = 1 << 3 +}; + +enum ImNodesAttributeType_ +{ + ImNodesAttributeType_None, + ImNodesAttributeType_Input, + ImNodesAttributeType_Output +}; + +enum ImNodesUIState_ +{ + ImNodesUIState_None = 0, + ImNodesUIState_LinkStarted = 1 << 0, + ImNodesUIState_LinkDropped = 1 << 1, + ImNodesUIState_LinkCreated = 1 << 2 +}; + +enum ImNodesClickInteractionType_ +{ + ImNodesClickInteractionType_Node, + ImNodesClickInteractionType_Link, + ImNodesClickInteractionType_LinkCreation, + ImNodesClickInteractionType_Panning, + ImNodesClickInteractionType_BoxSelection, + ImNodesClickInteractionType_ImGuiItem, + ImNodesClickInteractionType_None +}; + +enum ImNodesLinkCreationType_ +{ + ImNodesLinkCreationType_Standard, + ImNodesLinkCreationType_FromDetach +}; + +// [SECTION] internal data structures + +// The object T must have the following interface: +// +// struct T +// { +// T(); +// +// int id; +// }; +template +struct ImObjectPool +{ + ImVector Pool; + ImVector InUse; + ImVector FreeList; + ImGuiStorage IdMap; + + ImObjectPool() : Pool(), InUse(), FreeList(), IdMap() {} +}; + +// Emulates std::optional using the sentinel value `INVALID_INDEX`. +struct ImOptionalIndex +{ + ImOptionalIndex() : _Index(INVALID_INDEX) {} + ImOptionalIndex(const int value) : _Index(value) {} + + // Observers + + inline bool HasValue() const { return _Index != INVALID_INDEX; } + + inline int Value() const + { + assert(HasValue()); + return _Index; + } + + // Modifiers + + inline ImOptionalIndex& operator=(const int value) + { + _Index = value; + return *this; + } + + inline void Reset() { _Index = INVALID_INDEX; } + + inline bool operator==(const ImOptionalIndex& rhs) const { return _Index == rhs._Index; } + + inline bool operator==(const int rhs) const { return _Index == rhs; } + + inline bool operator!=(const ImOptionalIndex& rhs) const { return _Index != rhs._Index; } + + inline bool operator!=(const int rhs) const { return _Index != rhs; } + + static const int INVALID_INDEX = -1; + +private: + int _Index; +}; + +struct ImNodeData +{ + int Id; + ImVec2 Origin; // The node origin is in editor space + ImRect TitleBarContentRect; + ImRect Rect; + + struct + { + ImU32 Background, BackgroundHovered, BackgroundSelected, Outline, Titlebar, TitlebarHovered, + TitlebarSelected; + } ColorStyle; + + struct + { + float CornerRounding; + ImVec2 Padding; + float BorderThickness; + } LayoutStyle; + + ImVector PinIndices; + bool Draggable; + + ImNodeData(const int node_id) + : Id(node_id), Origin(100.0f, 100.0f), TitleBarContentRect(), + Rect(ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f), ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f)), ColorStyle(), LayoutStyle(), PinIndices(), + Draggable(true) + { + } + + ~ImNodeData() { Id = INT_MIN; } +}; + +struct ImPinData +{ + int Id; + int ParentNodeIdx; + ImRect AttributeRect; + ImNodesAttributeType Type; + ImNodesPinShape Shape; + ImVec2 Pos; // screen-space coordinates + int Flags; + + struct + { + ImU32 Background, Hovered; + } ColorStyle; + + ImPinData(const int pin_id) + : Id(pin_id), ParentNodeIdx(), AttributeRect(), Type(ImNodesAttributeType_None), + Shape(ImNodesPinShape_CircleFilled), Pos(), Flags(ImNodesAttributeFlags_None), + ColorStyle() + { + } +}; + +struct ImLinkData +{ + int Id; + int StartPinIdx, EndPinIdx; + + struct + { + ImU32 Base, Hovered, Selected; + } ColorStyle; + + ImLinkData(const int link_id) : Id(link_id), StartPinIdx(), EndPinIdx(), ColorStyle() {} +}; + +struct ImClickInteractionState +{ + ImNodesClickInteractionType Type; + + struct + { + int StartPinIdx; + ImOptionalIndex EndPinIdx; + ImNodesLinkCreationType Type; + } LinkCreation; + + struct + { + ImRect Rect; // Coordinates in grid space + } BoxSelector; + + ImClickInteractionState() : Type(ImNodesClickInteractionType_None) {} +}; + +struct ImNodesColElement +{ + ImU32 Color; + ImNodesCol Item; + + ImNodesColElement(const ImU32 c, const ImNodesCol s) : Color(c), Item(s) {} +}; + +struct ImNodesStyleVarElement +{ + ImNodesStyleVar Item; + float FloatValue[2]; + + ImNodesStyleVarElement(const ImNodesStyleVar variable, const float value) : Item(variable) + { + FloatValue[0] = value; + } + + ImNodesStyleVarElement(const ImNodesStyleVar variable, const ImVec2 value) : Item(variable) + { + FloatValue[0] = value.x; + FloatValue[1] = value.y; + } +}; + +// [SECTION] global and editor context structs + +struct ImNodesEditorContext +{ + ImObjectPool Nodes; + ImObjectPool Pins; + ImObjectPool Links; + + ImVector NodeDepthOrder; + + // ui related fields + ImVec2 Panning; + ImVec2 AutoPanningDelta; + // Minimum and maximum extents of all content in grid space. Valid after final + // ImNodes::EndNode() call. + ImRect GridContentBounds; + + ImVector SelectedNodeIndices; + ImVector SelectedLinkIndices; + + ImClickInteractionState ClickInteraction; + + // Mini-map state set by MiniMap() + + bool MiniMapEnabled; + ImNodesMiniMapLocation MiniMapLocation; + float MiniMapSizeFraction; + ImNodesMiniMapNodeHoveringCallback MiniMapNodeHoveringCallback; + ImNodesMiniMapNodeHoveringCallbackUserData MiniMapNodeHoveringCallbackUserData; + + // Mini-map state set during EndNodeEditor() call + + ImRect MiniMapRectScreenSpace; + ImRect MiniMapContentScreenSpace; + float MiniMapScaling; + + ImNodesEditorContext() + : Nodes(), Pins(), Links(), Panning(0.f, 0.f), SelectedNodeIndices(), SelectedLinkIndices(), + ClickInteraction(), MiniMapEnabled(false), MiniMapSizeFraction(0.0f), + MiniMapNodeHoveringCallback(NULL), MiniMapNodeHoveringCallbackUserData(NULL), + MiniMapScaling(0.0f) + { + } +}; + +struct ImNodesContext +{ + ImNodesEditorContext* DefaultEditorCtx; + ImNodesEditorContext* EditorCtx; + + // Canvas draw list and helper state + ImDrawList* CanvasDrawList; + ImGuiStorage NodeIdxToSubmissionIdx; + ImVector NodeIdxSubmissionOrder; + ImVector NodeIndicesOverlappingWithMouse; + ImVector OccludedPinIndices; + + // Canvas extents + ImVec2 CanvasOriginScreenSpace; + ImRect CanvasRectScreenSpace; + + // Debug helpers + ImNodesScope CurrentScope; + + // Configuration state + ImNodesIO Io; + ImNodesStyle Style; + ImVector ColorModifierStack; + ImVector StyleModifierStack; + ImGuiTextBuffer TextBuffer; + + int CurrentAttributeFlags; + ImVector AttributeFlagStack; + + // UI element state + int CurrentNodeIdx; + int CurrentPinIdx; + int CurrentAttributeId; + + ImOptionalIndex HoveredNodeIdx; + ImOptionalIndex HoveredLinkIdx; + ImOptionalIndex HoveredPinIdx; + + ImOptionalIndex DeletedLinkIdx; + ImOptionalIndex SnapLinkIdx; + + // Event helper state + // TODO: this should be a part of a state machine, and not a member of the global struct. + // Unclear what parts of the code this relates to. + int ImNodesUIState; + + int ActiveAttributeId; + bool ActiveAttribute; + + // ImGui::IO cache + + ImVec2 MousePos; + + bool LeftMouseClicked; + bool LeftMouseReleased; + bool AltMouseClicked; + bool LeftMouseDragging; + bool AltMouseDragging; + float AltMouseScrollDelta; +}; + +namespace IMNODES_NAMESPACE +{ +static inline ImNodesEditorContext& EditorContextGet() +{ + // No editor context was set! Did you forget to call ImNodes::CreateContext()? + assert(GImNodes->EditorCtx != NULL); + return *GImNodes->EditorCtx; +} + +// [SECTION] ObjectPool implementation + +template +static inline int ObjectPoolFind(const ImObjectPool& objects, const int id) +{ + const int index = objects.IdMap.GetInt(static_cast(id), -1); + return index; +} + +template +static inline void ObjectPoolUpdate(ImObjectPool& objects) +{ + for (int i = 0; i < objects.InUse.size(); ++i) + { + const int id = objects.Pool[i].Id; + + if (!objects.InUse[i] && objects.IdMap.GetInt(id, -1) == i) + { + objects.IdMap.SetInt(id, -1); + objects.FreeList.push_back(i); + (objects.Pool.Data + i)->~T(); + } + } +} + +template<> +inline void ObjectPoolUpdate(ImObjectPool& nodes) +{ + for (int i = 0; i < nodes.InUse.size(); ++i) + { + if (nodes.InUse[i]) + { + nodes.Pool[i].PinIndices.clear(); + } + else + { + const int id = nodes.Pool[i].Id; + + if (nodes.IdMap.GetInt(id, -1) == i) + { + // Remove node idx form depth stack the first time we detect that this idx slot is + // unused + ImVector& depth_stack = EditorContextGet().NodeDepthOrder; + const int* const elem = depth_stack.find(i); + assert(elem != depth_stack.end()); + depth_stack.erase(elem); + + nodes.IdMap.SetInt(id, -1); + nodes.FreeList.push_back(i); + (nodes.Pool.Data + i)->~ImNodeData(); + } + } + } +} + +template +static inline void ObjectPoolReset(ImObjectPool& objects) +{ + if (!objects.InUse.empty()) + { + memset(objects.InUse.Data, 0, objects.InUse.size_in_bytes()); + } +} + +template +static inline int ObjectPoolFindOrCreateIndex(ImObjectPool& objects, const int id) +{ + int index = objects.IdMap.GetInt(static_cast(id), -1); + + // Construct new object + if (index == -1) + { + if (objects.FreeList.empty()) + { + index = objects.Pool.size(); + IM_ASSERT(objects.Pool.size() == objects.InUse.size()); + const int new_size = objects.Pool.size() + 1; + objects.Pool.resize(new_size); + objects.InUse.resize(new_size); + } + else + { + index = objects.FreeList.back(); + objects.FreeList.pop_back(); + } + IM_PLACEMENT_NEW(objects.Pool.Data + index) T(id); + objects.IdMap.SetInt(static_cast(id), index); + } + + // Flag it as used + objects.InUse[index] = true; + + return index; +} + +template<> +inline int ObjectPoolFindOrCreateIndex(ImObjectPool& nodes, const int node_id) +{ + int node_idx = nodes.IdMap.GetInt(static_cast(node_id), -1); + + // Construct new node + if (node_idx == -1) + { + if (nodes.FreeList.empty()) + { + node_idx = nodes.Pool.size(); + IM_ASSERT(nodes.Pool.size() == nodes.InUse.size()); + const int new_size = nodes.Pool.size() + 1; + nodes.Pool.resize(new_size); + nodes.InUse.resize(new_size); + } + else + { + node_idx = nodes.FreeList.back(); + nodes.FreeList.pop_back(); + } + IM_PLACEMENT_NEW(nodes.Pool.Data + node_idx) ImNodeData(node_id); + nodes.IdMap.SetInt(static_cast(node_id), node_idx); + + ImNodesEditorContext& editor = EditorContextGet(); + editor.NodeDepthOrder.push_back(node_idx); + } + + // Flag node as used + nodes.InUse[node_idx] = true; + + return node_idx; +} + +template +static inline T& ObjectPoolFindOrCreateObject(ImObjectPool& objects, const int id) +{ + const int index = ObjectPoolFindOrCreateIndex(objects, id); + return objects.Pool[index]; +} +} // namespace IMNODES_NAMESPACE diff --git a/3rdparty/imnodes/premake5.lua b/3rdparty/imnodes/premake5.lua new file mode 100644 index 0000000..6d621ea --- /dev/null +++ b/3rdparty/imnodes/premake5.lua @@ -0,0 +1,154 @@ +newoption { + trigger = "sdl-include-path", + value = "path", + description = "The location of your SDL2 header files" +} + +newoption { + trigger = "sdl-link-path", + value = "path", + description = "The location of your SDL2 link libraries" +} + +newoption { + trigger = "use-sdl-framework", + description = "Use the installed SDL2 framework (on MacOS)" +} + +local projectlocation = os.getcwd() +local gl3wlocation = path.join(os.getcwd(), "dependencies/gl3w") +local imguilocation = path.join(os.getcwd(), "dependencies/imgui-1.84.2") + +if _ACTION then + projectlocation = path.join(projectlocation, "build", _ACTION) +end + +function imnodes_example_project(name, example_file) + project(name) + location(projectlocation) + kind "ConsoleApp" + language "C++" + cppdialect "C++11" + targetdir "bin/%{cfg.buildcfg}" + debugdir "bin/%{cfg.buildcfg}" + files {"example/main.cpp", path.join("example", example_file) } + includedirs { + os.getcwd(), + imguilocation, + path.join(gl3wlocation, "include"), + } + links { "gl3w", "imgui", "imnodes" } + + defines { "IMGUI_IMPL_OPENGL_LOADER_GL3W" } + + if _OPTIONS["sdl-include-path"] then + includedirs { _OPTIONS["sdl-include-path"] } + end + + if _OPTIONS["sdl-link-path"] then + libdirs { _OPTIONS["sdl-link-path"] } + + filter "system:macosx" + links { + "iconv", + "AudioToolbox.framework", + "Carbon.framework", + "Cocoa.framework", + "CoreAudio.framework", + "CoreVideo.framework", + "ForceFeedback.framework", + "IOKit.framework" + } + filter "*" + end + + if _OPTIONS["use-sdl-framework"] then + includedirs { "/Library/Frameworks/SDL2.framework/Headers" } + linkoptions { "-F/Library/Frameworks -framework SDL2 -framework CoreFoundation" } + else + links { "SDL2" } + end + + filter "system:windows" + defines { "SDL_MAIN_HANDLED" } + links { "opengl32" } + if _OPTIONS["sdl-link-path"] then + postbuildcommands { + "{COPY} " .. + path.join(os.getcwd(), _OPTIONS["sdl-link-path"].."/../bin/", "SDL2.dll") .. + " %{cfg.targetdir}" } + end + + filter "system:linux" + links { "dl" } +end + +workspace "imnodes" + configurations { "Debug", "Release" } + architecture "x86_64" + defines { "IMGUI_DISABLE_OBSOLETE_FUNCTIONS" } + + filter "configurations:Debug" + symbols "On" + + filter "configurations:Release" + defines { "NDEBUG" } + optimize "On" + + filter "action:vs*" + defines { "_CRT_SECURE_NO_WARNINGS" } + + warnings "Extra" + + startproject "colornode" + + group "dependencies" + + project "gl3w" + location(projectlocation) + kind "StaticLib" + language "C" + targetdir "lib/%{cfg.buildcfg}" + files { path.join(gl3wlocation, "src/gl3w.c") } + includedirs { path.join(gl3wlocation, "include") } + + project "imgui" + location(projectlocation) + kind "StaticLib" + language "C++" + cppdialect "C++98" + targetdir "lib/%{cfg.buildcfg}" + files { path.join(imguilocation, "**.cpp") } + includedirs { + imguilocation, + path.join(gl3wlocation, "include") } + + if _OPTIONS["sdl-include-path"] then + includedirs { _OPTIONS["sdl-include-path"] } + end + + if _OPTIONS["use-sdl-framework"] then + includedirs { "/Library/Frameworks/SDL2.framework/Headers" } + end + + group "imnodes" + + project "imnodes" + location(projectlocation) + kind "StaticLib" + language "C++" + cppdialect "C++98" + enablewarnings { "all" } + targetdir "lib/%{cfg.buildcfg}" + files { "imnodes.h", "imnodes_internal.h", "imnodes.cpp" } + includedirs { path.join(imguilocation) } + + group "examples" + + imnodes_example_project("hello", "hello.cpp") + + imnodes_example_project("saveload", "save_load.cpp") + + imnodes_example_project("colornode", "color_node_editor.cpp") + + imnodes_example_project("multieditor", "multi_editor.cpp") diff --git a/3rdparty/json/LICENSE.MIT b/3rdparty/json/LICENSE.MIT new file mode 100644 index 0000000..1c1f7a6 --- /dev/null +++ b/3rdparty/json/LICENSE.MIT @@ -0,0 +1,21 @@ +MIT License + +Copyright (c) 2013-2022 Niels Lohmann + +Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy +of this software and associated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal +in the Software without restriction, including without limitation the rights +to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell +copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is +furnished to do so, subject to the following conditions: + +The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in all +copies or substantial portions of the Software. + +THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR +IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, +FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE +AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER +LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, +OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE +SOFTWARE. diff --git a/3rdparty/json/json.hpp b/3rdparty/json/json.hpp new file mode 100644 index 0000000..e40e3b0 --- /dev/null +++ b/3rdparty/json/json.hpp @@ -0,0 +1,22109 @@ +/* + __ _____ _____ _____ + __| | __| | | | JSON for Modern C++ +| | |__ | | | | | | version 3.10.5 +|_____|_____|_____|_|___| https://github.com/nlohmann/json + +Licensed under the MIT License . +SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT +Copyright (c) 2013-2022 Niels Lohmann . + +Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy +of this software and associated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal +in the Software without restriction, including without limitation the rights +to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell +copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is +furnished to do so, subject to the following conditions: + +The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in all +copies or substantial portions of the Software. + +THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR +IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, +FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE +AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER +LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, +OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE +SOFTWARE. +*/ + +/****************************************************************************\ + * Note on documentation: The source files contain links to the online * + * documentation of the public API at https://json.nlohmann.me. This URL * + * contains the most recent documentation and should also be applicable to * + * previous versions; documentation for deprecated functions is not * + * removed, but marked deprecated. See "Generate documentation" section in * + * file doc/README.md. * +\****************************************************************************/ + +#ifndef INCLUDE_NLOHMANN_JSON_HPP_ +#define INCLUDE_NLOHMANN_JSON_HPP_ + +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_VERSION_MAJOR 3 +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_VERSION_MINOR 10 +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_VERSION_PATCH 5 + +#include // all_of, find, for_each +#include // nullptr_t, ptrdiff_t, size_t +#include // hash, less +#include // initializer_list +#ifndef JSON_NO_IO + #include // istream, ostream +#endif // JSON_NO_IO +#include // random_access_iterator_tag +#include // unique_ptr +#include // accumulate +#include // string, stoi, to_string +#include // declval, forward, move, pair, swap +#include // vector + +// #include + + +#include +#include + +// #include + + +#include // transform +#include // array +#include // forward_list +#include // inserter, front_inserter, end +#include // map +#include // string +#include // tuple, make_tuple +#include // is_arithmetic, is_same, is_enum, underlying_type, is_convertible +#include // unordered_map +#include // pair, declval +#include // valarray + +// #include + + +#include // exception +#include // runtime_error +#include // to_string +#include // vector + +// #include + + +#include // array +#include // size_t +#include // uint8_t +#include // string + +namespace nlohmann +{ +namespace detail +{ +/////////////////////////// +// JSON type enumeration // +/////////////////////////// + +/*! +@brief the JSON type enumeration + +This enumeration collects the different JSON types. It is internally used to +distinguish the stored values, and the functions @ref basic_json::is_null(), +@ref basic_json::is_object(), @ref basic_json::is_array(), +@ref basic_json::is_string(), @ref basic_json::is_boolean(), +@ref basic_json::is_number() (with @ref basic_json::is_number_integer(), +@ref basic_json::is_number_unsigned(), and @ref basic_json::is_number_float()), +@ref basic_json::is_discarded(), @ref basic_json::is_primitive(), and +@ref basic_json::is_structured() rely on it. + +@note There are three enumeration entries (number_integer, number_unsigned, and +number_float), because the library distinguishes these three types for numbers: +@ref basic_json::number_unsigned_t is used for unsigned integers, +@ref basic_json::number_integer_t is used for signed integers, and +@ref basic_json::number_float_t is used for floating-point numbers or to +approximate integers which do not fit in the limits of their respective type. + +@sa see @ref basic_json::basic_json(const value_t value_type) -- create a JSON +value with the default value for a given type + +@since version 1.0.0 +*/ +enum class value_t : std::uint8_t +{ + null, ///< null value + object, ///< object (unordered set of name/value pairs) + array, ///< array (ordered collection of values) + string, ///< string value + boolean, ///< boolean value + number_integer, ///< number value (signed integer) + number_unsigned, ///< number value (unsigned integer) + number_float, ///< number value (floating-point) + binary, ///< binary array (ordered collection of bytes) + discarded ///< discarded by the parser callback function +}; + +/*! +@brief comparison operator for JSON types + +Returns an ordering that is similar to Python: +- order: null < boolean < number < object < array < string < binary +- furthermore, each type is not smaller than itself +- discarded values are not comparable +- binary is represented as a b"" string in python and directly comparable to a + string; however, making a binary array directly comparable with a string would + be surprising behavior in a JSON file. + +@since version 1.0.0 +*/ +inline bool operator<(const value_t lhs, const value_t rhs) noexcept +{ + static constexpr std::array order = {{ + 0 /* null */, 3 /* object */, 4 /* array */, 5 /* string */, + 1 /* boolean */, 2 /* integer */, 2 /* unsigned */, 2 /* float */, + 6 /* binary */ + } + }; + + const auto l_index = static_cast(lhs); + const auto r_index = static_cast(rhs); + return l_index < order.size() && r_index < order.size() && order[l_index] < order[r_index]; +} +} // namespace detail +} // namespace nlohmann + +// #include + + +#include +// #include + + +#include // declval, pair +// #include + + +/* Hedley - https://nemequ.github.io/hedley + * Created by Evan Nemerson + * + * To the extent possible under law, the author(s) have dedicated all + * copyright and related and neighboring rights to this software to + * the public domain worldwide. This software is distributed without + * any warranty. + * + * For details, see . + * SPDX-License-Identifier: CC0-1.0 + */ + +#if !defined(JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION) || (JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION < 15) +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION +#endif +#define JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION 15 + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_STRINGIFY_EX) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_STRINGIFY_EX +#endif +#define JSON_HEDLEY_STRINGIFY_EX(x) #x + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_STRINGIFY) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_STRINGIFY +#endif +#define JSON_HEDLEY_STRINGIFY(x) JSON_HEDLEY_STRINGIFY_EX(x) + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_CONCAT_EX) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_CONCAT_EX +#endif +#define JSON_HEDLEY_CONCAT_EX(a,b) a##b + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_CONCAT) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_CONCAT +#endif +#define JSON_HEDLEY_CONCAT(a,b) JSON_HEDLEY_CONCAT_EX(a,b) + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_CONCAT3_EX) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_CONCAT3_EX +#endif +#define JSON_HEDLEY_CONCAT3_EX(a,b,c) a##b##c + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_CONCAT3) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_CONCAT3 +#endif +#define JSON_HEDLEY_CONCAT3(a,b,c) JSON_HEDLEY_CONCAT3_EX(a,b,c) + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE +#endif +#define JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE(major,minor,revision) (((major) * 1000000) + ((minor) * 1000) + (revision)) + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_DECODE_MAJOR) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_DECODE_MAJOR +#endif +#define JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_DECODE_MAJOR(version) ((version) / 1000000) + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_DECODE_MINOR) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_DECODE_MINOR +#endif +#define JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_DECODE_MINOR(version) (((version) % 1000000) / 1000) + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_DECODE_REVISION) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_DECODE_REVISION +#endif +#define JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_DECODE_REVISION(version) ((version) % 1000) + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_GNUC_VERSION) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_GNUC_VERSION +#endif +#if defined(__GNUC__) && defined(__GNUC_PATCHLEVEL__) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_GNUC_VERSION JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE(__GNUC__, __GNUC_MINOR__, __GNUC_PATCHLEVEL__) +#elif defined(__GNUC__) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_GNUC_VERSION JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE(__GNUC__, __GNUC_MINOR__, 0) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_GNUC_VERSION_CHECK) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_GNUC_VERSION_CHECK +#endif +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_GNUC_VERSION) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_GNUC_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) (JSON_HEDLEY_GNUC_VERSION >= JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE(major, minor, patch)) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_GNUC_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) (0) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_MSVC_VERSION) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_MSVC_VERSION +#endif +#if defined(_MSC_FULL_VER) && (_MSC_FULL_VER >= 140000000) && !defined(__ICL) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_MSVC_VERSION JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE(_MSC_FULL_VER / 10000000, (_MSC_FULL_VER % 10000000) / 100000, (_MSC_FULL_VER % 100000) / 100) +#elif defined(_MSC_FULL_VER) && !defined(__ICL) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_MSVC_VERSION JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE(_MSC_FULL_VER / 1000000, (_MSC_FULL_VER % 1000000) / 10000, (_MSC_FULL_VER % 10000) / 10) +#elif defined(_MSC_VER) && !defined(__ICL) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_MSVC_VERSION JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE(_MSC_VER / 100, _MSC_VER % 100, 0) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_MSVC_VERSION_CHECK) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_MSVC_VERSION_CHECK +#endif +#if !defined(JSON_HEDLEY_MSVC_VERSION) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_MSVC_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) (0) +#elif defined(_MSC_VER) && (_MSC_VER >= 1400) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_MSVC_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) (_MSC_FULL_VER >= ((major * 10000000) + (minor * 100000) + (patch))) +#elif defined(_MSC_VER) && (_MSC_VER >= 1200) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_MSVC_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) (_MSC_FULL_VER >= ((major * 1000000) + (minor * 10000) + (patch))) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_MSVC_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) (_MSC_VER >= ((major * 100) + (minor))) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_VERSION) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_VERSION +#endif +#if defined(__INTEL_COMPILER) && defined(__INTEL_COMPILER_UPDATE) && !defined(__ICL) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_VERSION JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE(__INTEL_COMPILER / 100, __INTEL_COMPILER % 100, __INTEL_COMPILER_UPDATE) +#elif defined(__INTEL_COMPILER) && !defined(__ICL) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_VERSION JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE(__INTEL_COMPILER / 100, __INTEL_COMPILER % 100, 0) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_VERSION_CHECK) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_VERSION_CHECK +#endif +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_VERSION) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) (JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_VERSION >= JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE(major, minor, patch)) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) (0) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_CL_VERSION) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_CL_VERSION +#endif +#if defined(__INTEL_COMPILER) && defined(__INTEL_COMPILER_UPDATE) && defined(__ICL) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_CL_VERSION JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE(__INTEL_COMPILER, __INTEL_COMPILER_UPDATE, 0) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_CL_VERSION_CHECK) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_CL_VERSION_CHECK +#endif +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_CL_VERSION) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_CL_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) (JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_CL_VERSION >= JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE(major, minor, patch)) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_CL_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) (0) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_PGI_VERSION) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_PGI_VERSION +#endif +#if defined(__PGI) && defined(__PGIC__) && defined(__PGIC_MINOR__) && defined(__PGIC_PATCHLEVEL__) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_PGI_VERSION JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE(__PGIC__, __PGIC_MINOR__, __PGIC_PATCHLEVEL__) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_PGI_VERSION_CHECK) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_PGI_VERSION_CHECK +#endif +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_PGI_VERSION) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_PGI_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) (JSON_HEDLEY_PGI_VERSION >= JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE(major, minor, patch)) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_PGI_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) (0) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_SUNPRO_VERSION) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_SUNPRO_VERSION +#endif +#if defined(__SUNPRO_C) && (__SUNPRO_C > 0x1000) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_SUNPRO_VERSION JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE((((__SUNPRO_C >> 16) & 0xf) * 10) + ((__SUNPRO_C >> 12) & 0xf), (((__SUNPRO_C >> 8) & 0xf) * 10) + ((__SUNPRO_C >> 4) & 0xf), (__SUNPRO_C & 0xf) * 10) +#elif defined(__SUNPRO_C) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_SUNPRO_VERSION JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE((__SUNPRO_C >> 8) & 0xf, (__SUNPRO_C >> 4) & 0xf, (__SUNPRO_C) & 0xf) +#elif defined(__SUNPRO_CC) && (__SUNPRO_CC > 0x1000) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_SUNPRO_VERSION JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE((((__SUNPRO_CC >> 16) & 0xf) * 10) + ((__SUNPRO_CC >> 12) & 0xf), (((__SUNPRO_CC >> 8) & 0xf) * 10) + ((__SUNPRO_CC >> 4) & 0xf), (__SUNPRO_CC & 0xf) * 10) +#elif defined(__SUNPRO_CC) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_SUNPRO_VERSION JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE((__SUNPRO_CC >> 8) & 0xf, (__SUNPRO_CC >> 4) & 0xf, (__SUNPRO_CC) & 0xf) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_SUNPRO_VERSION_CHECK) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_SUNPRO_VERSION_CHECK +#endif +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_SUNPRO_VERSION) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_SUNPRO_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) (JSON_HEDLEY_SUNPRO_VERSION >= JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE(major, minor, patch)) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_SUNPRO_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) (0) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_EMSCRIPTEN_VERSION) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_EMSCRIPTEN_VERSION +#endif +#if defined(__EMSCRIPTEN__) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_EMSCRIPTEN_VERSION JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE(__EMSCRIPTEN_major__, __EMSCRIPTEN_minor__, __EMSCRIPTEN_tiny__) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_EMSCRIPTEN_VERSION_CHECK) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_EMSCRIPTEN_VERSION_CHECK +#endif +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_EMSCRIPTEN_VERSION) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_EMSCRIPTEN_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) (JSON_HEDLEY_EMSCRIPTEN_VERSION >= JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE(major, minor, patch)) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_EMSCRIPTEN_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) (0) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_ARM_VERSION) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_ARM_VERSION +#endif +#if defined(__CC_ARM) && defined(__ARMCOMPILER_VERSION) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_ARM_VERSION JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE(__ARMCOMPILER_VERSION / 1000000, (__ARMCOMPILER_VERSION % 1000000) / 10000, (__ARMCOMPILER_VERSION % 10000) / 100) +#elif defined(__CC_ARM) && defined(__ARMCC_VERSION) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_ARM_VERSION JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE(__ARMCC_VERSION / 1000000, (__ARMCC_VERSION % 1000000) / 10000, (__ARMCC_VERSION % 10000) / 100) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_ARM_VERSION_CHECK) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_ARM_VERSION_CHECK +#endif +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_ARM_VERSION) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_ARM_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) (JSON_HEDLEY_ARM_VERSION >= JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE(major, minor, patch)) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_ARM_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) (0) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_IBM_VERSION) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_IBM_VERSION +#endif +#if defined(__ibmxl__) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_IBM_VERSION JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE(__ibmxl_version__, __ibmxl_release__, __ibmxl_modification__) +#elif defined(__xlC__) && defined(__xlC_ver__) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_IBM_VERSION JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE(__xlC__ >> 8, __xlC__ & 0xff, (__xlC_ver__ >> 8) & 0xff) +#elif defined(__xlC__) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_IBM_VERSION JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE(__xlC__ >> 8, __xlC__ & 0xff, 0) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_IBM_VERSION_CHECK) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_IBM_VERSION_CHECK +#endif +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_IBM_VERSION) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_IBM_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) (JSON_HEDLEY_IBM_VERSION >= JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE(major, minor, patch)) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_IBM_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) (0) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_TI_VERSION) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_TI_VERSION +#endif +#if \ + defined(__TI_COMPILER_VERSION__) && \ + ( \ + defined(__TMS470__) || defined(__TI_ARM__) || \ + defined(__MSP430__) || \ + defined(__TMS320C2000__) \ + ) +#if (__TI_COMPILER_VERSION__ >= 16000000) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_TI_VERSION JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE(__TI_COMPILER_VERSION__ / 1000000, (__TI_COMPILER_VERSION__ % 1000000) / 1000, (__TI_COMPILER_VERSION__ % 1000)) +#endif +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_TI_VERSION_CHECK) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_TI_VERSION_CHECK +#endif +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_TI_VERSION) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_TI_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) (JSON_HEDLEY_TI_VERSION >= JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE(major, minor, patch)) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_TI_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) (0) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL2000_VERSION) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL2000_VERSION +#endif +#if defined(__TI_COMPILER_VERSION__) && defined(__TMS320C2000__) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL2000_VERSION JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE(__TI_COMPILER_VERSION__ / 1000000, (__TI_COMPILER_VERSION__ % 1000000) / 1000, (__TI_COMPILER_VERSION__ % 1000)) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL2000_VERSION_CHECK) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL2000_VERSION_CHECK +#endif +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL2000_VERSION) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL2000_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) (JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL2000_VERSION >= JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE(major, minor, patch)) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL2000_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) (0) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL430_VERSION) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL430_VERSION +#endif +#if defined(__TI_COMPILER_VERSION__) && defined(__MSP430__) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL430_VERSION JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE(__TI_COMPILER_VERSION__ / 1000000, (__TI_COMPILER_VERSION__ % 1000000) / 1000, (__TI_COMPILER_VERSION__ % 1000)) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL430_VERSION_CHECK) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL430_VERSION_CHECK +#endif +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL430_VERSION) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL430_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) (JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL430_VERSION >= JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE(major, minor, patch)) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL430_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) (0) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_TI_ARMCL_VERSION) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_TI_ARMCL_VERSION +#endif +#if defined(__TI_COMPILER_VERSION__) && (defined(__TMS470__) || defined(__TI_ARM__)) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_TI_ARMCL_VERSION JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE(__TI_COMPILER_VERSION__ / 1000000, (__TI_COMPILER_VERSION__ % 1000000) / 1000, (__TI_COMPILER_VERSION__ % 1000)) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_TI_ARMCL_VERSION_CHECK) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_TI_ARMCL_VERSION_CHECK +#endif +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_TI_ARMCL_VERSION) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_TI_ARMCL_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) (JSON_HEDLEY_TI_ARMCL_VERSION >= JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE(major, minor, patch)) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_TI_ARMCL_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) (0) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL6X_VERSION) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL6X_VERSION +#endif +#if defined(__TI_COMPILER_VERSION__) && defined(__TMS320C6X__) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL6X_VERSION JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE(__TI_COMPILER_VERSION__ / 1000000, (__TI_COMPILER_VERSION__ % 1000000) / 1000, (__TI_COMPILER_VERSION__ % 1000)) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL6X_VERSION_CHECK) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL6X_VERSION_CHECK +#endif +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL6X_VERSION) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL6X_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) (JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL6X_VERSION >= JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE(major, minor, patch)) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL6X_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) (0) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL7X_VERSION) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL7X_VERSION +#endif +#if defined(__TI_COMPILER_VERSION__) && defined(__C7000__) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL7X_VERSION JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE(__TI_COMPILER_VERSION__ / 1000000, (__TI_COMPILER_VERSION__ % 1000000) / 1000, (__TI_COMPILER_VERSION__ % 1000)) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL7X_VERSION_CHECK) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL7X_VERSION_CHECK +#endif +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL7X_VERSION) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL7X_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) (JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL7X_VERSION >= JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE(major, minor, patch)) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL7X_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) (0) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CLPRU_VERSION) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CLPRU_VERSION +#endif +#if defined(__TI_COMPILER_VERSION__) && defined(__PRU__) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CLPRU_VERSION JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE(__TI_COMPILER_VERSION__ / 1000000, (__TI_COMPILER_VERSION__ % 1000000) / 1000, (__TI_COMPILER_VERSION__ % 1000)) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CLPRU_VERSION_CHECK) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CLPRU_VERSION_CHECK +#endif +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CLPRU_VERSION) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CLPRU_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) (JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CLPRU_VERSION >= JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE(major, minor, patch)) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CLPRU_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) (0) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_CRAY_VERSION) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_CRAY_VERSION +#endif +#if defined(_CRAYC) + #if defined(_RELEASE_PATCHLEVEL) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_CRAY_VERSION JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE(_RELEASE_MAJOR, _RELEASE_MINOR, _RELEASE_PATCHLEVEL) + #else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_CRAY_VERSION JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE(_RELEASE_MAJOR, _RELEASE_MINOR, 0) + #endif +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_CRAY_VERSION_CHECK) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_CRAY_VERSION_CHECK +#endif +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_CRAY_VERSION) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_CRAY_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) (JSON_HEDLEY_CRAY_VERSION >= JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE(major, minor, patch)) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_CRAY_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) (0) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_IAR_VERSION) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_IAR_VERSION +#endif +#if defined(__IAR_SYSTEMS_ICC__) + #if __VER__ > 1000 + #define JSON_HEDLEY_IAR_VERSION JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE((__VER__ / 1000000), ((__VER__ / 1000) % 1000), (__VER__ % 1000)) + #else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_IAR_VERSION JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE(__VER__ / 100, __VER__ % 100, 0) + #endif +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_IAR_VERSION_CHECK) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_IAR_VERSION_CHECK +#endif +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_IAR_VERSION) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_IAR_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) (JSON_HEDLEY_IAR_VERSION >= JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE(major, minor, patch)) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_IAR_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) (0) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_TINYC_VERSION) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_TINYC_VERSION +#endif +#if defined(__TINYC__) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_TINYC_VERSION JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE(__TINYC__ / 1000, (__TINYC__ / 100) % 10, __TINYC__ % 100) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_TINYC_VERSION_CHECK) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_TINYC_VERSION_CHECK +#endif +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_TINYC_VERSION) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_TINYC_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) (JSON_HEDLEY_TINYC_VERSION >= JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE(major, minor, patch)) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_TINYC_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) (0) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_DMC_VERSION) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_DMC_VERSION +#endif +#if defined(__DMC__) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DMC_VERSION JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE(__DMC__ >> 8, (__DMC__ >> 4) & 0xf, __DMC__ & 0xf) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_DMC_VERSION_CHECK) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_DMC_VERSION_CHECK +#endif +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_DMC_VERSION) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DMC_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) (JSON_HEDLEY_DMC_VERSION >= JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE(major, minor, patch)) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DMC_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) (0) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_COMPCERT_VERSION) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_COMPCERT_VERSION +#endif +#if defined(__COMPCERT_VERSION__) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_COMPCERT_VERSION JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE(__COMPCERT_VERSION__ / 10000, (__COMPCERT_VERSION__ / 100) % 100, __COMPCERT_VERSION__ % 100) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_COMPCERT_VERSION_CHECK) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_COMPCERT_VERSION_CHECK +#endif +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_COMPCERT_VERSION) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_COMPCERT_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) (JSON_HEDLEY_COMPCERT_VERSION >= JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE(major, minor, patch)) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_COMPCERT_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) (0) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_PELLES_VERSION) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_PELLES_VERSION +#endif +#if defined(__POCC__) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_PELLES_VERSION JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE(__POCC__ / 100, __POCC__ % 100, 0) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_PELLES_VERSION_CHECK) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_PELLES_VERSION_CHECK +#endif +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_PELLES_VERSION) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_PELLES_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) (JSON_HEDLEY_PELLES_VERSION >= JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE(major, minor, patch)) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_PELLES_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) (0) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_MCST_LCC_VERSION) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_MCST_LCC_VERSION +#endif +#if defined(__LCC__) && defined(__LCC_MINOR__) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_MCST_LCC_VERSION JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE(__LCC__ / 100, __LCC__ % 100, __LCC_MINOR__) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_MCST_LCC_VERSION_CHECK) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_MCST_LCC_VERSION_CHECK +#endif +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_MCST_LCC_VERSION) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_MCST_LCC_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) (JSON_HEDLEY_MCST_LCC_VERSION >= JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE(major, minor, patch)) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_MCST_LCC_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) (0) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_VERSION) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_VERSION +#endif +#if \ + defined(JSON_HEDLEY_GNUC_VERSION) && \ + !defined(__clang__) && \ + !defined(JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_VERSION) && \ + !defined(JSON_HEDLEY_PGI_VERSION) && \ + !defined(JSON_HEDLEY_ARM_VERSION) && \ + !defined(JSON_HEDLEY_CRAY_VERSION) && \ + !defined(JSON_HEDLEY_TI_VERSION) && \ + !defined(JSON_HEDLEY_TI_ARMCL_VERSION) && \ + !defined(JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL430_VERSION) && \ + !defined(JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL2000_VERSION) && \ + !defined(JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL6X_VERSION) && \ + !defined(JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL7X_VERSION) && \ + !defined(JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CLPRU_VERSION) && \ + !defined(__COMPCERT__) && \ + !defined(JSON_HEDLEY_MCST_LCC_VERSION) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_VERSION JSON_HEDLEY_GNUC_VERSION +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_VERSION_CHECK) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_VERSION_CHECK +#endif +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_VERSION) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) (JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_VERSION >= JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE(major, minor, patch)) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) (0) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_ATTRIBUTE) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_ATTRIBUTE +#endif +#if \ + defined(__has_attribute) && \ + ( \ + (!defined(JSON_HEDLEY_IAR_VERSION) || JSON_HEDLEY_IAR_VERSION_CHECK(8,5,9)) \ + ) +# define JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_ATTRIBUTE(attribute) __has_attribute(attribute) +#else +# define JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_ATTRIBUTE(attribute) (0) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_GNUC_HAS_ATTRIBUTE) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_GNUC_HAS_ATTRIBUTE +#endif +#if defined(__has_attribute) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_GNUC_HAS_ATTRIBUTE(attribute,major,minor,patch) JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_ATTRIBUTE(attribute) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_GNUC_HAS_ATTRIBUTE(attribute,major,minor,patch) JSON_HEDLEY_GNUC_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_HAS_ATTRIBUTE) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_HAS_ATTRIBUTE +#endif +#if defined(__has_attribute) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_HAS_ATTRIBUTE(attribute,major,minor,patch) JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_ATTRIBUTE(attribute) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_HAS_ATTRIBUTE(attribute,major,minor,patch) JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_CPP_ATTRIBUTE) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_CPP_ATTRIBUTE +#endif +#if \ + defined(__has_cpp_attribute) && \ + defined(__cplusplus) && \ + (!defined(JSON_HEDLEY_SUNPRO_VERSION) || JSON_HEDLEY_SUNPRO_VERSION_CHECK(5,15,0)) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_CPP_ATTRIBUTE(attribute) __has_cpp_attribute(attribute) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_CPP_ATTRIBUTE(attribute) (0) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_CPP_ATTRIBUTE_NS) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_CPP_ATTRIBUTE_NS +#endif +#if !defined(__cplusplus) || !defined(__has_cpp_attribute) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_CPP_ATTRIBUTE_NS(ns,attribute) (0) +#elif \ + !defined(JSON_HEDLEY_PGI_VERSION) && \ + !defined(JSON_HEDLEY_IAR_VERSION) && \ + (!defined(JSON_HEDLEY_SUNPRO_VERSION) || JSON_HEDLEY_SUNPRO_VERSION_CHECK(5,15,0)) && \ + (!defined(JSON_HEDLEY_MSVC_VERSION) || JSON_HEDLEY_MSVC_VERSION_CHECK(19,20,0)) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_CPP_ATTRIBUTE_NS(ns,attribute) JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_CPP_ATTRIBUTE(ns::attribute) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_CPP_ATTRIBUTE_NS(ns,attribute) (0) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_GNUC_HAS_CPP_ATTRIBUTE) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_GNUC_HAS_CPP_ATTRIBUTE +#endif +#if defined(__has_cpp_attribute) && defined(__cplusplus) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_GNUC_HAS_CPP_ATTRIBUTE(attribute,major,minor,patch) __has_cpp_attribute(attribute) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_GNUC_HAS_CPP_ATTRIBUTE(attribute,major,minor,patch) JSON_HEDLEY_GNUC_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_HAS_CPP_ATTRIBUTE) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_HAS_CPP_ATTRIBUTE +#endif +#if defined(__has_cpp_attribute) && defined(__cplusplus) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_HAS_CPP_ATTRIBUTE(attribute,major,minor,patch) __has_cpp_attribute(attribute) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_HAS_CPP_ATTRIBUTE(attribute,major,minor,patch) JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_BUILTIN) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_BUILTIN +#endif +#if defined(__has_builtin) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_BUILTIN(builtin) __has_builtin(builtin) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_BUILTIN(builtin) (0) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_GNUC_HAS_BUILTIN) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_GNUC_HAS_BUILTIN +#endif +#if defined(__has_builtin) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_GNUC_HAS_BUILTIN(builtin,major,minor,patch) __has_builtin(builtin) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_GNUC_HAS_BUILTIN(builtin,major,minor,patch) JSON_HEDLEY_GNUC_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_HAS_BUILTIN) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_HAS_BUILTIN +#endif +#if defined(__has_builtin) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_HAS_BUILTIN(builtin,major,minor,patch) __has_builtin(builtin) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_HAS_BUILTIN(builtin,major,minor,patch) JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_FEATURE) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_FEATURE +#endif +#if defined(__has_feature) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_FEATURE(feature) __has_feature(feature) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_FEATURE(feature) (0) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_GNUC_HAS_FEATURE) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_GNUC_HAS_FEATURE +#endif +#if defined(__has_feature) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_GNUC_HAS_FEATURE(feature,major,minor,patch) __has_feature(feature) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_GNUC_HAS_FEATURE(feature,major,minor,patch) JSON_HEDLEY_GNUC_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_HAS_FEATURE) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_HAS_FEATURE +#endif +#if defined(__has_feature) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_HAS_FEATURE(feature,major,minor,patch) __has_feature(feature) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_HAS_FEATURE(feature,major,minor,patch) JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_EXTENSION) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_EXTENSION +#endif +#if defined(__has_extension) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_EXTENSION(extension) __has_extension(extension) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_EXTENSION(extension) (0) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_GNUC_HAS_EXTENSION) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_GNUC_HAS_EXTENSION +#endif +#if defined(__has_extension) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_GNUC_HAS_EXTENSION(extension,major,minor,patch) __has_extension(extension) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_GNUC_HAS_EXTENSION(extension,major,minor,patch) JSON_HEDLEY_GNUC_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_HAS_EXTENSION) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_HAS_EXTENSION +#endif +#if defined(__has_extension) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_HAS_EXTENSION(extension,major,minor,patch) __has_extension(extension) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_HAS_EXTENSION(extension,major,minor,patch) JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_DECLSPEC_ATTRIBUTE) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_DECLSPEC_ATTRIBUTE +#endif +#if defined(__has_declspec_attribute) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_DECLSPEC_ATTRIBUTE(attribute) __has_declspec_attribute(attribute) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_DECLSPEC_ATTRIBUTE(attribute) (0) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_GNUC_HAS_DECLSPEC_ATTRIBUTE) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_GNUC_HAS_DECLSPEC_ATTRIBUTE +#endif +#if defined(__has_declspec_attribute) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_GNUC_HAS_DECLSPEC_ATTRIBUTE(attribute,major,minor,patch) __has_declspec_attribute(attribute) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_GNUC_HAS_DECLSPEC_ATTRIBUTE(attribute,major,minor,patch) JSON_HEDLEY_GNUC_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_HAS_DECLSPEC_ATTRIBUTE) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_HAS_DECLSPEC_ATTRIBUTE +#endif +#if defined(__has_declspec_attribute) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_HAS_DECLSPEC_ATTRIBUTE(attribute,major,minor,patch) __has_declspec_attribute(attribute) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_HAS_DECLSPEC_ATTRIBUTE(attribute,major,minor,patch) JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_WARNING) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_WARNING +#endif +#if defined(__has_warning) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_WARNING(warning) __has_warning(warning) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_WARNING(warning) (0) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_GNUC_HAS_WARNING) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_GNUC_HAS_WARNING +#endif +#if defined(__has_warning) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_GNUC_HAS_WARNING(warning,major,minor,patch) __has_warning(warning) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_GNUC_HAS_WARNING(warning,major,minor,patch) JSON_HEDLEY_GNUC_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_HAS_WARNING) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_HAS_WARNING +#endif +#if defined(__has_warning) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_HAS_WARNING(warning,major,minor,patch) __has_warning(warning) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_HAS_WARNING(warning,major,minor,patch) JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) +#endif + +#if \ + (defined(__STDC_VERSION__) && (__STDC_VERSION__ >= 199901L)) || \ + defined(__clang__) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_VERSION_CHECK(3,0,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_VERSION_CHECK(13,0,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_IAR_VERSION_CHECK(8,0,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_PGI_VERSION_CHECK(18,4,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_ARM_VERSION_CHECK(4,1,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_VERSION_CHECK(15,12,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_ARMCL_VERSION_CHECK(4,7,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL430_VERSION_CHECK(2,0,1) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL2000_VERSION_CHECK(6,1,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL6X_VERSION_CHECK(7,0,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL7X_VERSION_CHECK(1,2,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CLPRU_VERSION_CHECK(2,1,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_CRAY_VERSION_CHECK(5,0,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TINYC_VERSION_CHECK(0,9,17) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_SUNPRO_VERSION_CHECK(8,0,0) || \ + (JSON_HEDLEY_IBM_VERSION_CHECK(10,1,0) && defined(__C99_PRAGMA_OPERATOR)) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_PRAGMA(value) _Pragma(#value) +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_MSVC_VERSION_CHECK(15,0,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_PRAGMA(value) __pragma(value) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_PRAGMA(value) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_PUSH) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_PUSH +#endif +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_POP) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_POP +#endif +#if defined(__clang__) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_PUSH _Pragma("clang diagnostic push") + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_POP _Pragma("clang diagnostic pop") +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_VERSION_CHECK(13,0,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_PUSH _Pragma("warning(push)") + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_POP _Pragma("warning(pop)") +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_VERSION_CHECK(4,6,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_PUSH _Pragma("GCC diagnostic push") + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_POP _Pragma("GCC diagnostic pop") +#elif \ + JSON_HEDLEY_MSVC_VERSION_CHECK(15,0,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_CL_VERSION_CHECK(2021,1,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_PUSH __pragma(warning(push)) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_POP __pragma(warning(pop)) +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_ARM_VERSION_CHECK(5,6,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_PUSH _Pragma("push") + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_POP _Pragma("pop") +#elif \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_VERSION_CHECK(15,12,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_ARMCL_VERSION_CHECK(5,2,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL430_VERSION_CHECK(4,4,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL6X_VERSION_CHECK(8,1,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL7X_VERSION_CHECK(1,2,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CLPRU_VERSION_CHECK(2,1,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_PUSH _Pragma("diag_push") + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_POP _Pragma("diag_pop") +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_PELLES_VERSION_CHECK(2,90,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_PUSH _Pragma("warning(push)") + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_POP _Pragma("warning(pop)") +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_PUSH + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_POP +#endif + +/* JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_CPP98_COMPAT_WRAP_ is for + HEDLEY INTERNAL USE ONLY. API subject to change without notice. */ +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_CPP98_COMPAT_WRAP_) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_CPP98_COMPAT_WRAP_ +#endif +#if defined(__cplusplus) +# if JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_WARNING("-Wc++98-compat") +# if JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_WARNING("-Wc++17-extensions") +# if JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_WARNING("-Wc++1z-extensions") +# define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_CPP98_COMPAT_WRAP_(xpr) \ + JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_PUSH \ + _Pragma("clang diagnostic ignored \"-Wc++98-compat\"") \ + _Pragma("clang diagnostic ignored \"-Wc++17-extensions\"") \ + _Pragma("clang diagnostic ignored \"-Wc++1z-extensions\"") \ + xpr \ + JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_POP +# else +# define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_CPP98_COMPAT_WRAP_(xpr) \ + JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_PUSH \ + _Pragma("clang diagnostic ignored \"-Wc++98-compat\"") \ + _Pragma("clang diagnostic ignored \"-Wc++17-extensions\"") \ + xpr \ + JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_POP +# endif +# else +# define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_CPP98_COMPAT_WRAP_(xpr) \ + JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_PUSH \ + _Pragma("clang diagnostic ignored \"-Wc++98-compat\"") \ + xpr \ + JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_POP +# endif +# endif +#endif +#if !defined(JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_CPP98_COMPAT_WRAP_) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_CPP98_COMPAT_WRAP_(x) x +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_CONST_CAST) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_CONST_CAST +#endif +#if defined(__cplusplus) +# define JSON_HEDLEY_CONST_CAST(T, expr) (const_cast(expr)) +#elif \ + JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_WARNING("-Wcast-qual") || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_VERSION_CHECK(4,6,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_VERSION_CHECK(13,0,0) +# define JSON_HEDLEY_CONST_CAST(T, expr) (__extension__ ({ \ + JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_PUSH \ + JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_CAST_QUAL \ + ((T) (expr)); \ + JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_POP \ + })) +#else +# define JSON_HEDLEY_CONST_CAST(T, expr) ((T) (expr)) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_REINTERPRET_CAST) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_REINTERPRET_CAST +#endif +#if defined(__cplusplus) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_REINTERPRET_CAST(T, expr) (reinterpret_cast(expr)) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_REINTERPRET_CAST(T, expr) ((T) (expr)) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_STATIC_CAST) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_STATIC_CAST +#endif +#if defined(__cplusplus) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_STATIC_CAST(T, expr) (static_cast(expr)) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_STATIC_CAST(T, expr) ((T) (expr)) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_CPP_CAST) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_CPP_CAST +#endif +#if defined(__cplusplus) +# if JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_WARNING("-Wold-style-cast") +# define JSON_HEDLEY_CPP_CAST(T, expr) \ + JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_PUSH \ + _Pragma("clang diagnostic ignored \"-Wold-style-cast\"") \ + ((T) (expr)) \ + JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_POP +# elif JSON_HEDLEY_IAR_VERSION_CHECK(8,3,0) +# define JSON_HEDLEY_CPP_CAST(T, expr) \ + JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_PUSH \ + _Pragma("diag_suppress=Pe137") \ + JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_POP +# else +# define JSON_HEDLEY_CPP_CAST(T, expr) ((T) (expr)) +# endif +#else +# define JSON_HEDLEY_CPP_CAST(T, expr) (expr) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_DEPRECATED) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_DEPRECATED +#endif +#if JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_WARNING("-Wdeprecated-declarations") + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_DEPRECATED _Pragma("clang diagnostic ignored \"-Wdeprecated-declarations\"") +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_VERSION_CHECK(13,0,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_DEPRECATED _Pragma("warning(disable:1478 1786)") +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_CL_VERSION_CHECK(2021,1,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_DEPRECATED __pragma(warning(disable:1478 1786)) +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_PGI_VERSION_CHECK(20,7,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_DEPRECATED _Pragma("diag_suppress 1215,1216,1444,1445") +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_PGI_VERSION_CHECK(17,10,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_DEPRECATED _Pragma("diag_suppress 1215,1444") +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_VERSION_CHECK(4,3,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_DEPRECATED _Pragma("GCC diagnostic ignored \"-Wdeprecated-declarations\"") +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_MSVC_VERSION_CHECK(15,0,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_DEPRECATED __pragma(warning(disable:4996)) +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_MCST_LCC_VERSION_CHECK(1,25,10) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_DEPRECATED _Pragma("diag_suppress 1215,1444") +#elif \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_VERSION_CHECK(15,12,0) || \ + (JSON_HEDLEY_TI_ARMCL_VERSION_CHECK(4,8,0) && defined(__TI_GNU_ATTRIBUTE_SUPPORT__)) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_ARMCL_VERSION_CHECK(5,2,0) || \ + (JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL2000_VERSION_CHECK(6,0,0) && defined(__TI_GNU_ATTRIBUTE_SUPPORT__)) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL2000_VERSION_CHECK(6,4,0) || \ + (JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL430_VERSION_CHECK(4,0,0) && defined(__TI_GNU_ATTRIBUTE_SUPPORT__)) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL430_VERSION_CHECK(4,3,0) || \ + (JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL6X_VERSION_CHECK(7,2,0) && defined(__TI_GNU_ATTRIBUTE_SUPPORT__)) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL6X_VERSION_CHECK(7,5,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL7X_VERSION_CHECK(1,2,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CLPRU_VERSION_CHECK(2,1,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_DEPRECATED _Pragma("diag_suppress 1291,1718") +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_SUNPRO_VERSION_CHECK(5,13,0) && !defined(__cplusplus) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_DEPRECATED _Pragma("error_messages(off,E_DEPRECATED_ATT,E_DEPRECATED_ATT_MESS)") +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_SUNPRO_VERSION_CHECK(5,13,0) && defined(__cplusplus) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_DEPRECATED _Pragma("error_messages(off,symdeprecated,symdeprecated2)") +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_IAR_VERSION_CHECK(8,0,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_DEPRECATED _Pragma("diag_suppress=Pe1444,Pe1215") +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_PELLES_VERSION_CHECK(2,90,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_DEPRECATED _Pragma("warn(disable:2241)") +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_DEPRECATED +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_UNKNOWN_PRAGMAS) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_UNKNOWN_PRAGMAS +#endif +#if JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_WARNING("-Wunknown-pragmas") + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_UNKNOWN_PRAGMAS _Pragma("clang diagnostic ignored \"-Wunknown-pragmas\"") +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_VERSION_CHECK(13,0,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_UNKNOWN_PRAGMAS _Pragma("warning(disable:161)") +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_CL_VERSION_CHECK(2021,1,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_UNKNOWN_PRAGMAS __pragma(warning(disable:161)) +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_PGI_VERSION_CHECK(17,10,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_UNKNOWN_PRAGMAS _Pragma("diag_suppress 1675") +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_VERSION_CHECK(4,3,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_UNKNOWN_PRAGMAS _Pragma("GCC diagnostic ignored \"-Wunknown-pragmas\"") +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_MSVC_VERSION_CHECK(15,0,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_UNKNOWN_PRAGMAS __pragma(warning(disable:4068)) +#elif \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_VERSION_CHECK(16,9,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL6X_VERSION_CHECK(8,0,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL7X_VERSION_CHECK(1,2,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CLPRU_VERSION_CHECK(2,3,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_UNKNOWN_PRAGMAS _Pragma("diag_suppress 163") +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL6X_VERSION_CHECK(8,0,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_UNKNOWN_PRAGMAS _Pragma("diag_suppress 163") +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_IAR_VERSION_CHECK(8,0,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_UNKNOWN_PRAGMAS _Pragma("diag_suppress=Pe161") +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_MCST_LCC_VERSION_CHECK(1,25,10) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_UNKNOWN_PRAGMAS _Pragma("diag_suppress 161") +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_UNKNOWN_PRAGMAS +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_UNKNOWN_CPP_ATTRIBUTES) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_UNKNOWN_CPP_ATTRIBUTES +#endif +#if JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_WARNING("-Wunknown-attributes") + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_UNKNOWN_CPP_ATTRIBUTES _Pragma("clang diagnostic ignored \"-Wunknown-attributes\"") +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_VERSION_CHECK(4,6,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_UNKNOWN_CPP_ATTRIBUTES _Pragma("GCC diagnostic ignored \"-Wdeprecated-declarations\"") +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_VERSION_CHECK(17,0,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_UNKNOWN_CPP_ATTRIBUTES _Pragma("warning(disable:1292)") +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_CL_VERSION_CHECK(2021,1,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_UNKNOWN_CPP_ATTRIBUTES __pragma(warning(disable:1292)) +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_MSVC_VERSION_CHECK(19,0,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_UNKNOWN_CPP_ATTRIBUTES __pragma(warning(disable:5030)) +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_PGI_VERSION_CHECK(20,7,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_UNKNOWN_CPP_ATTRIBUTES _Pragma("diag_suppress 1097,1098") +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_PGI_VERSION_CHECK(17,10,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_UNKNOWN_CPP_ATTRIBUTES _Pragma("diag_suppress 1097") +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_SUNPRO_VERSION_CHECK(5,14,0) && defined(__cplusplus) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_UNKNOWN_CPP_ATTRIBUTES _Pragma("error_messages(off,attrskipunsup)") +#elif \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_VERSION_CHECK(18,1,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL6X_VERSION_CHECK(8,3,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL7X_VERSION_CHECK(1,2,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_UNKNOWN_CPP_ATTRIBUTES _Pragma("diag_suppress 1173") +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_IAR_VERSION_CHECK(8,0,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_UNKNOWN_CPP_ATTRIBUTES _Pragma("diag_suppress=Pe1097") +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_MCST_LCC_VERSION_CHECK(1,25,10) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_UNKNOWN_CPP_ATTRIBUTES _Pragma("diag_suppress 1097") +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_UNKNOWN_CPP_ATTRIBUTES +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_CAST_QUAL) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_CAST_QUAL +#endif +#if JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_WARNING("-Wcast-qual") + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_CAST_QUAL _Pragma("clang diagnostic ignored \"-Wcast-qual\"") +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_VERSION_CHECK(13,0,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_CAST_QUAL _Pragma("warning(disable:2203 2331)") +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_VERSION_CHECK(3,0,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_CAST_QUAL _Pragma("GCC diagnostic ignored \"-Wcast-qual\"") +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_CAST_QUAL +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_UNUSED_FUNCTION) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_UNUSED_FUNCTION +#endif +#if JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_WARNING("-Wunused-function") + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_UNUSED_FUNCTION _Pragma("clang diagnostic ignored \"-Wunused-function\"") +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_VERSION_CHECK(3,4,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_UNUSED_FUNCTION _Pragma("GCC diagnostic ignored \"-Wunused-function\"") +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_MSVC_VERSION_CHECK(1,0,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_UNUSED_FUNCTION __pragma(warning(disable:4505)) +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_MCST_LCC_VERSION_CHECK(1,25,10) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_UNUSED_FUNCTION _Pragma("diag_suppress 3142") +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_UNUSED_FUNCTION +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_DEPRECATED) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_DEPRECATED +#endif +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_DEPRECATED_FOR) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_DEPRECATED_FOR +#endif +#if \ + JSON_HEDLEY_MSVC_VERSION_CHECK(14,0,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_CL_VERSION_CHECK(2021,1,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DEPRECATED(since) __declspec(deprecated("Since " # since)) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DEPRECATED_FOR(since, replacement) __declspec(deprecated("Since " #since "; use " #replacement)) +#elif \ + (JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_EXTENSION(attribute_deprecated_with_message) && !defined(JSON_HEDLEY_IAR_VERSION)) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_VERSION_CHECK(4,5,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_VERSION_CHECK(13,0,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_ARM_VERSION_CHECK(5,6,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_SUNPRO_VERSION_CHECK(5,13,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_PGI_VERSION_CHECK(17,10,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_VERSION_CHECK(18,1,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_ARMCL_VERSION_CHECK(18,1,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL6X_VERSION_CHECK(8,3,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL7X_VERSION_CHECK(1,2,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CLPRU_VERSION_CHECK(2,3,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_MCST_LCC_VERSION_CHECK(1,25,10) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DEPRECATED(since) __attribute__((__deprecated__("Since " #since))) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DEPRECATED_FOR(since, replacement) __attribute__((__deprecated__("Since " #since "; use " #replacement))) +#elif defined(__cplusplus) && (__cplusplus >= 201402L) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DEPRECATED(since) JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_CPP98_COMPAT_WRAP_([[deprecated("Since " #since)]]) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DEPRECATED_FOR(since, replacement) JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_CPP98_COMPAT_WRAP_([[deprecated("Since " #since "; use " #replacement)]]) +#elif \ + JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_ATTRIBUTE(deprecated) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_VERSION_CHECK(3,1,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_ARM_VERSION_CHECK(4,1,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_VERSION_CHECK(15,12,0) || \ + (JSON_HEDLEY_TI_ARMCL_VERSION_CHECK(4,8,0) && defined(__TI_GNU_ATTRIBUTE_SUPPORT__)) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_ARMCL_VERSION_CHECK(5,2,0) || \ + (JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL2000_VERSION_CHECK(6,0,0) && defined(__TI_GNU_ATTRIBUTE_SUPPORT__)) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL2000_VERSION_CHECK(6,4,0) || \ + (JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL430_VERSION_CHECK(4,0,0) && defined(__TI_GNU_ATTRIBUTE_SUPPORT__)) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL430_VERSION_CHECK(4,3,0) || \ + (JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL6X_VERSION_CHECK(7,2,0) && defined(__TI_GNU_ATTRIBUTE_SUPPORT__)) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL6X_VERSION_CHECK(7,5,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL7X_VERSION_CHECK(1,2,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CLPRU_VERSION_CHECK(2,1,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_MCST_LCC_VERSION_CHECK(1,25,10) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_IAR_VERSION_CHECK(8,10,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DEPRECATED(since) __attribute__((__deprecated__)) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DEPRECATED_FOR(since, replacement) __attribute__((__deprecated__)) +#elif \ + JSON_HEDLEY_MSVC_VERSION_CHECK(13,10,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_PELLES_VERSION_CHECK(6,50,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_CL_VERSION_CHECK(2021,1,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DEPRECATED(since) __declspec(deprecated) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DEPRECATED_FOR(since, replacement) __declspec(deprecated) +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_IAR_VERSION_CHECK(8,0,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DEPRECATED(since) _Pragma("deprecated") + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DEPRECATED_FOR(since, replacement) _Pragma("deprecated") +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DEPRECATED(since) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_DEPRECATED_FOR(since, replacement) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_UNAVAILABLE) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_UNAVAILABLE +#endif +#if \ + JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_ATTRIBUTE(warning) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_VERSION_CHECK(4,3,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_VERSION_CHECK(13,0,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_MCST_LCC_VERSION_CHECK(1,25,10) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_UNAVAILABLE(available_since) __attribute__((__warning__("Not available until " #available_since))) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_UNAVAILABLE(available_since) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT +#endif +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT_MSG) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT_MSG +#endif +#if \ + JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_ATTRIBUTE(warn_unused_result) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_VERSION_CHECK(3,4,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_VERSION_CHECK(13,0,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_VERSION_CHECK(15,12,0) || \ + (JSON_HEDLEY_TI_ARMCL_VERSION_CHECK(4,8,0) && defined(__TI_GNU_ATTRIBUTE_SUPPORT__)) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_ARMCL_VERSION_CHECK(5,2,0) || \ + (JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL2000_VERSION_CHECK(6,0,0) && defined(__TI_GNU_ATTRIBUTE_SUPPORT__)) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL2000_VERSION_CHECK(6,4,0) || \ + (JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL430_VERSION_CHECK(4,0,0) && defined(__TI_GNU_ATTRIBUTE_SUPPORT__)) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL430_VERSION_CHECK(4,3,0) || \ + (JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL6X_VERSION_CHECK(7,2,0) && defined(__TI_GNU_ATTRIBUTE_SUPPORT__)) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL6X_VERSION_CHECK(7,5,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL7X_VERSION_CHECK(1,2,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CLPRU_VERSION_CHECK(2,1,0) || \ + (JSON_HEDLEY_SUNPRO_VERSION_CHECK(5,15,0) && defined(__cplusplus)) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_PGI_VERSION_CHECK(17,10,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_MCST_LCC_VERSION_CHECK(1,25,10) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT __attribute__((__warn_unused_result__)) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT_MSG(msg) __attribute__((__warn_unused_result__)) +#elif (JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_CPP_ATTRIBUTE(nodiscard) >= 201907L) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_CPP98_COMPAT_WRAP_([[nodiscard]]) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT_MSG(msg) JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_CPP98_COMPAT_WRAP_([[nodiscard(msg)]]) +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_CPP_ATTRIBUTE(nodiscard) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_CPP98_COMPAT_WRAP_([[nodiscard]]) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT_MSG(msg) JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_CPP98_COMPAT_WRAP_([[nodiscard]]) +#elif defined(_Check_return_) /* SAL */ + #define JSON_HEDLEY_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT _Check_return_ + #define JSON_HEDLEY_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT_MSG(msg) _Check_return_ +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT + #define JSON_HEDLEY_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT_MSG(msg) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_SENTINEL) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_SENTINEL +#endif +#if \ + JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_ATTRIBUTE(sentinel) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_VERSION_CHECK(4,0,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_VERSION_CHECK(13,0,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_ARM_VERSION_CHECK(5,4,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_MCST_LCC_VERSION_CHECK(1,25,10) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_SENTINEL(position) __attribute__((__sentinel__(position))) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_SENTINEL(position) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_NO_RETURN) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_NO_RETURN +#endif +#if JSON_HEDLEY_IAR_VERSION_CHECK(8,0,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_NO_RETURN __noreturn +#elif \ + JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_VERSION_CHECK(13,0,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_MCST_LCC_VERSION_CHECK(1,25,10) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_NO_RETURN __attribute__((__noreturn__)) +#elif defined(__STDC_VERSION__) && __STDC_VERSION__ >= 201112L + #define JSON_HEDLEY_NO_RETURN _Noreturn +#elif defined(__cplusplus) && (__cplusplus >= 201103L) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_NO_RETURN JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_CPP98_COMPAT_WRAP_([[noreturn]]) +#elif \ + JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_ATTRIBUTE(noreturn) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_VERSION_CHECK(3,2,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_SUNPRO_VERSION_CHECK(5,11,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_ARM_VERSION_CHECK(4,1,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_IBM_VERSION_CHECK(10,1,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_VERSION_CHECK(15,12,0) || \ + (JSON_HEDLEY_TI_ARMCL_VERSION_CHECK(4,8,0) && defined(__TI_GNU_ATTRIBUTE_SUPPORT__)) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_ARMCL_VERSION_CHECK(5,2,0) || \ + (JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL2000_VERSION_CHECK(6,0,0) && defined(__TI_GNU_ATTRIBUTE_SUPPORT__)) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL2000_VERSION_CHECK(6,4,0) || \ + (JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL430_VERSION_CHECK(4,0,0) && defined(__TI_GNU_ATTRIBUTE_SUPPORT__)) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL430_VERSION_CHECK(4,3,0) || \ + (JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL6X_VERSION_CHECK(7,2,0) && defined(__TI_GNU_ATTRIBUTE_SUPPORT__)) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL6X_VERSION_CHECK(7,5,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL7X_VERSION_CHECK(1,2,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CLPRU_VERSION_CHECK(2,1,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_IAR_VERSION_CHECK(8,10,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_NO_RETURN __attribute__((__noreturn__)) +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_SUNPRO_VERSION_CHECK(5,10,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_NO_RETURN _Pragma("does_not_return") +#elif \ + JSON_HEDLEY_MSVC_VERSION_CHECK(13,10,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_CL_VERSION_CHECK(2021,1,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_NO_RETURN __declspec(noreturn) +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL6X_VERSION_CHECK(6,0,0) && defined(__cplusplus) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_NO_RETURN _Pragma("FUNC_NEVER_RETURNS;") +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_COMPCERT_VERSION_CHECK(3,2,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_NO_RETURN __attribute((noreturn)) +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_PELLES_VERSION_CHECK(9,0,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_NO_RETURN __declspec(noreturn) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_NO_RETURN +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_NO_ESCAPE) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_NO_ESCAPE +#endif +#if JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_ATTRIBUTE(noescape) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_NO_ESCAPE __attribute__((__noescape__)) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_NO_ESCAPE +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_UNREACHABLE) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_UNREACHABLE +#endif +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_UNREACHABLE_RETURN) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_UNREACHABLE_RETURN +#endif +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_ASSUME) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_ASSUME +#endif +#if \ + JSON_HEDLEY_MSVC_VERSION_CHECK(13,10,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_VERSION_CHECK(13,0,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_CL_VERSION_CHECK(2021,1,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_ASSUME(expr) __assume(expr) +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_BUILTIN(__builtin_assume) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_ASSUME(expr) __builtin_assume(expr) +#elif \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL2000_VERSION_CHECK(6,2,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL6X_VERSION_CHECK(4,0,0) + #if defined(__cplusplus) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_ASSUME(expr) std::_nassert(expr) + #else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_ASSUME(expr) _nassert(expr) + #endif +#endif +#if \ + (JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_BUILTIN(__builtin_unreachable) && (!defined(JSON_HEDLEY_ARM_VERSION))) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_VERSION_CHECK(4,5,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_PGI_VERSION_CHECK(18,10,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_VERSION_CHECK(13,0,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_IBM_VERSION_CHECK(13,1,5) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_CRAY_VERSION_CHECK(10,0,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_MCST_LCC_VERSION_CHECK(1,25,10) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_UNREACHABLE() __builtin_unreachable() +#elif defined(JSON_HEDLEY_ASSUME) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_UNREACHABLE() JSON_HEDLEY_ASSUME(0) +#endif +#if !defined(JSON_HEDLEY_ASSUME) + #if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_UNREACHABLE) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_ASSUME(expr) JSON_HEDLEY_STATIC_CAST(void, ((expr) ? 1 : (JSON_HEDLEY_UNREACHABLE(), 1))) + #else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_ASSUME(expr) JSON_HEDLEY_STATIC_CAST(void, expr) + #endif +#endif +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_UNREACHABLE) + #if \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL2000_VERSION_CHECK(6,2,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL6X_VERSION_CHECK(4,0,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_UNREACHABLE_RETURN(value) return (JSON_HEDLEY_STATIC_CAST(void, JSON_HEDLEY_ASSUME(0)), (value)) + #else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_UNREACHABLE_RETURN(value) JSON_HEDLEY_UNREACHABLE() + #endif +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_UNREACHABLE_RETURN(value) return (value) +#endif +#if !defined(JSON_HEDLEY_UNREACHABLE) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_UNREACHABLE() JSON_HEDLEY_ASSUME(0) +#endif + +JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_PUSH +#if JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_WARNING("-Wpedantic") + #pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wpedantic" +#endif +#if JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_WARNING("-Wc++98-compat-pedantic") && defined(__cplusplus) + #pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wc++98-compat-pedantic" +#endif +#if JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_HAS_WARNING("-Wvariadic-macros",4,0,0) + #if defined(__clang__) + #pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wvariadic-macros" + #elif defined(JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_VERSION) + #pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wvariadic-macros" + #endif +#endif +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_NON_NULL) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_NON_NULL +#endif +#if \ + JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_ATTRIBUTE(nonnull) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_VERSION_CHECK(3,3,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_VERSION_CHECK(13,0,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_ARM_VERSION_CHECK(4,1,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_NON_NULL(...) __attribute__((__nonnull__(__VA_ARGS__))) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_NON_NULL(...) +#endif +JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_POP + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_PRINTF_FORMAT) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_PRINTF_FORMAT +#endif +#if defined(__MINGW32__) && JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_HAS_ATTRIBUTE(format,4,4,0) && !defined(__USE_MINGW_ANSI_STDIO) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_PRINTF_FORMAT(string_idx,first_to_check) __attribute__((__format__(ms_printf, string_idx, first_to_check))) +#elif defined(__MINGW32__) && JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_HAS_ATTRIBUTE(format,4,4,0) && defined(__USE_MINGW_ANSI_STDIO) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_PRINTF_FORMAT(string_idx,first_to_check) __attribute__((__format__(gnu_printf, string_idx, first_to_check))) +#elif \ + JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_ATTRIBUTE(format) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_VERSION_CHECK(3,1,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_VERSION_CHECK(13,0,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_ARM_VERSION_CHECK(5,6,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_IBM_VERSION_CHECK(10,1,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_VERSION_CHECK(15,12,0) || \ + (JSON_HEDLEY_TI_ARMCL_VERSION_CHECK(4,8,0) && defined(__TI_GNU_ATTRIBUTE_SUPPORT__)) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_ARMCL_VERSION_CHECK(5,2,0) || \ + (JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL2000_VERSION_CHECK(6,0,0) && defined(__TI_GNU_ATTRIBUTE_SUPPORT__)) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL2000_VERSION_CHECK(6,4,0) || \ + (JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL430_VERSION_CHECK(4,0,0) && defined(__TI_GNU_ATTRIBUTE_SUPPORT__)) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL430_VERSION_CHECK(4,3,0) || \ + (JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL6X_VERSION_CHECK(7,2,0) && defined(__TI_GNU_ATTRIBUTE_SUPPORT__)) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL6X_VERSION_CHECK(7,5,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL7X_VERSION_CHECK(1,2,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CLPRU_VERSION_CHECK(2,1,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_MCST_LCC_VERSION_CHECK(1,25,10) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_PRINTF_FORMAT(string_idx,first_to_check) __attribute__((__format__(__printf__, string_idx, first_to_check))) +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_PELLES_VERSION_CHECK(6,0,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_PRINTF_FORMAT(string_idx,first_to_check) __declspec(vaformat(printf,string_idx,first_to_check)) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_PRINTF_FORMAT(string_idx,first_to_check) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_CONSTEXPR) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_CONSTEXPR +#endif +#if defined(__cplusplus) + #if __cplusplus >= 201103L + #define JSON_HEDLEY_CONSTEXPR JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_CPP98_COMPAT_WRAP_(constexpr) + #endif +#endif +#if !defined(JSON_HEDLEY_CONSTEXPR) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_CONSTEXPR +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_PREDICT) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_PREDICT +#endif +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_LIKELY) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_LIKELY +#endif +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY +#endif +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_UNPREDICTABLE) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_UNPREDICTABLE +#endif +#if JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_BUILTIN(__builtin_unpredictable) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_UNPREDICTABLE(expr) __builtin_unpredictable((expr)) +#endif +#if \ + (JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_BUILTIN(__builtin_expect_with_probability) && !defined(JSON_HEDLEY_PGI_VERSION)) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_VERSION_CHECK(9,0,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_MCST_LCC_VERSION_CHECK(1,25,10) +# define JSON_HEDLEY_PREDICT(expr, value, probability) __builtin_expect_with_probability( (expr), (value), (probability)) +# define JSON_HEDLEY_PREDICT_TRUE(expr, probability) __builtin_expect_with_probability(!!(expr), 1 , (probability)) +# define JSON_HEDLEY_PREDICT_FALSE(expr, probability) __builtin_expect_with_probability(!!(expr), 0 , (probability)) +# define JSON_HEDLEY_LIKELY(expr) __builtin_expect (!!(expr), 1 ) +# define JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(expr) __builtin_expect (!!(expr), 0 ) +#elif \ + (JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_BUILTIN(__builtin_expect) && !defined(JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_CL_VERSION)) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_VERSION_CHECK(3,0,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_VERSION_CHECK(13,0,0) || \ + (JSON_HEDLEY_SUNPRO_VERSION_CHECK(5,15,0) && defined(__cplusplus)) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_ARM_VERSION_CHECK(4,1,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_IBM_VERSION_CHECK(10,1,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_VERSION_CHECK(15,12,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_ARMCL_VERSION_CHECK(4,7,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL430_VERSION_CHECK(3,1,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL2000_VERSION_CHECK(6,1,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL6X_VERSION_CHECK(6,1,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL7X_VERSION_CHECK(1,2,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CLPRU_VERSION_CHECK(2,1,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TINYC_VERSION_CHECK(0,9,27) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_CRAY_VERSION_CHECK(8,1,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_MCST_LCC_VERSION_CHECK(1,25,10) +# define JSON_HEDLEY_PREDICT(expr, expected, probability) \ + (((probability) >= 0.9) ? __builtin_expect((expr), (expected)) : (JSON_HEDLEY_STATIC_CAST(void, expected), (expr))) +# define JSON_HEDLEY_PREDICT_TRUE(expr, probability) \ + (__extension__ ({ \ + double hedley_probability_ = (probability); \ + ((hedley_probability_ >= 0.9) ? __builtin_expect(!!(expr), 1) : ((hedley_probability_ <= 0.1) ? __builtin_expect(!!(expr), 0) : !!(expr))); \ + })) +# define JSON_HEDLEY_PREDICT_FALSE(expr, probability) \ + (__extension__ ({ \ + double hedley_probability_ = (probability); \ + ((hedley_probability_ >= 0.9) ? __builtin_expect(!!(expr), 0) : ((hedley_probability_ <= 0.1) ? __builtin_expect(!!(expr), 1) : !!(expr))); \ + })) +# define JSON_HEDLEY_LIKELY(expr) __builtin_expect(!!(expr), 1) +# define JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(expr) __builtin_expect(!!(expr), 0) +#else +# define JSON_HEDLEY_PREDICT(expr, expected, probability) (JSON_HEDLEY_STATIC_CAST(void, expected), (expr)) +# define JSON_HEDLEY_PREDICT_TRUE(expr, probability) (!!(expr)) +# define JSON_HEDLEY_PREDICT_FALSE(expr, probability) (!!(expr)) +# define JSON_HEDLEY_LIKELY(expr) (!!(expr)) +# define JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(expr) (!!(expr)) +#endif +#if !defined(JSON_HEDLEY_UNPREDICTABLE) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_UNPREDICTABLE(expr) JSON_HEDLEY_PREDICT(expr, 1, 0.5) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_MALLOC) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_MALLOC +#endif +#if \ + JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_ATTRIBUTE(malloc) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_VERSION_CHECK(3,1,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_VERSION_CHECK(13,0,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_SUNPRO_VERSION_CHECK(5,11,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_ARM_VERSION_CHECK(4,1,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_IBM_VERSION_CHECK(12,1,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_VERSION_CHECK(15,12,0) || \ + (JSON_HEDLEY_TI_ARMCL_VERSION_CHECK(4,8,0) && defined(__TI_GNU_ATTRIBUTE_SUPPORT__)) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_ARMCL_VERSION_CHECK(5,2,0) || \ + (JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL2000_VERSION_CHECK(6,0,0) && defined(__TI_GNU_ATTRIBUTE_SUPPORT__)) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL2000_VERSION_CHECK(6,4,0) || \ + (JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL430_VERSION_CHECK(4,0,0) && defined(__TI_GNU_ATTRIBUTE_SUPPORT__)) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL430_VERSION_CHECK(4,3,0) || \ + (JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL6X_VERSION_CHECK(7,2,0) && defined(__TI_GNU_ATTRIBUTE_SUPPORT__)) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL6X_VERSION_CHECK(7,5,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL7X_VERSION_CHECK(1,2,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CLPRU_VERSION_CHECK(2,1,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_MCST_LCC_VERSION_CHECK(1,25,10) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_MALLOC __attribute__((__malloc__)) +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_SUNPRO_VERSION_CHECK(5,10,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_MALLOC _Pragma("returns_new_memory") +#elif \ + JSON_HEDLEY_MSVC_VERSION_CHECK(14,0,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_CL_VERSION_CHECK(2021,1,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_MALLOC __declspec(restrict) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_MALLOC +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_PURE) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_PURE +#endif +#if \ + JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_ATTRIBUTE(pure) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_VERSION_CHECK(2,96,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_VERSION_CHECK(13,0,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_SUNPRO_VERSION_CHECK(5,11,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_ARM_VERSION_CHECK(4,1,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_IBM_VERSION_CHECK(10,1,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_VERSION_CHECK(15,12,0) || \ + (JSON_HEDLEY_TI_ARMCL_VERSION_CHECK(4,8,0) && defined(__TI_GNU_ATTRIBUTE_SUPPORT__)) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_ARMCL_VERSION_CHECK(5,2,0) || \ + (JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL2000_VERSION_CHECK(6,0,0) && defined(__TI_GNU_ATTRIBUTE_SUPPORT__)) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL2000_VERSION_CHECK(6,4,0) || \ + (JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL430_VERSION_CHECK(4,0,0) && defined(__TI_GNU_ATTRIBUTE_SUPPORT__)) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL430_VERSION_CHECK(4,3,0) || \ + (JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL6X_VERSION_CHECK(7,2,0) && defined(__TI_GNU_ATTRIBUTE_SUPPORT__)) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL6X_VERSION_CHECK(7,5,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL7X_VERSION_CHECK(1,2,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CLPRU_VERSION_CHECK(2,1,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_PGI_VERSION_CHECK(17,10,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_MCST_LCC_VERSION_CHECK(1,25,10) +# define JSON_HEDLEY_PURE __attribute__((__pure__)) +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_SUNPRO_VERSION_CHECK(5,10,0) +# define JSON_HEDLEY_PURE _Pragma("does_not_write_global_data") +#elif defined(__cplusplus) && \ + ( \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL430_VERSION_CHECK(2,0,1) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL6X_VERSION_CHECK(4,0,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL7X_VERSION_CHECK(1,2,0) \ + ) +# define JSON_HEDLEY_PURE _Pragma("FUNC_IS_PURE;") +#else +# define JSON_HEDLEY_PURE +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_CONST) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_CONST +#endif +#if \ + JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_ATTRIBUTE(const) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_VERSION_CHECK(2,5,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_VERSION_CHECK(13,0,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_SUNPRO_VERSION_CHECK(5,11,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_ARM_VERSION_CHECK(4,1,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_IBM_VERSION_CHECK(10,1,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_VERSION_CHECK(15,12,0) || \ + (JSON_HEDLEY_TI_ARMCL_VERSION_CHECK(4,8,0) && defined(__TI_GNU_ATTRIBUTE_SUPPORT__)) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_ARMCL_VERSION_CHECK(5,2,0) || \ + (JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL2000_VERSION_CHECK(6,0,0) && defined(__TI_GNU_ATTRIBUTE_SUPPORT__)) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL2000_VERSION_CHECK(6,4,0) || \ + (JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL430_VERSION_CHECK(4,0,0) && defined(__TI_GNU_ATTRIBUTE_SUPPORT__)) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL430_VERSION_CHECK(4,3,0) || \ + (JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL6X_VERSION_CHECK(7,2,0) && defined(__TI_GNU_ATTRIBUTE_SUPPORT__)) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL6X_VERSION_CHECK(7,5,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL7X_VERSION_CHECK(1,2,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CLPRU_VERSION_CHECK(2,1,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_PGI_VERSION_CHECK(17,10,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_MCST_LCC_VERSION_CHECK(1,25,10) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_CONST __attribute__((__const__)) +#elif \ + JSON_HEDLEY_SUNPRO_VERSION_CHECK(5,10,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_CONST _Pragma("no_side_effect") +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_CONST JSON_HEDLEY_PURE +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_RESTRICT) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_RESTRICT +#endif +#if defined(__STDC_VERSION__) && (__STDC_VERSION__ >= 199901L) && !defined(__cplusplus) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_RESTRICT restrict +#elif \ + JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_VERSION_CHECK(3,1,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_MSVC_VERSION_CHECK(14,0,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_VERSION_CHECK(13,0,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_CL_VERSION_CHECK(2021,1,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_ARM_VERSION_CHECK(4,1,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_IBM_VERSION_CHECK(10,1,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_PGI_VERSION_CHECK(17,10,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL430_VERSION_CHECK(4,3,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL2000_VERSION_CHECK(6,2,4) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL6X_VERSION_CHECK(8,1,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL7X_VERSION_CHECK(1,2,0) || \ + (JSON_HEDLEY_SUNPRO_VERSION_CHECK(5,14,0) && defined(__cplusplus)) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_IAR_VERSION_CHECK(8,0,0) || \ + defined(__clang__) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_MCST_LCC_VERSION_CHECK(1,25,10) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_RESTRICT __restrict +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_SUNPRO_VERSION_CHECK(5,3,0) && !defined(__cplusplus) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_RESTRICT _Restrict +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_RESTRICT +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_INLINE) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_INLINE +#endif +#if \ + (defined(__STDC_VERSION__) && (__STDC_VERSION__ >= 199901L)) || \ + (defined(__cplusplus) && (__cplusplus >= 199711L)) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_INLINE inline +#elif \ + defined(JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_VERSION) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_ARM_VERSION_CHECK(6,2,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_INLINE __inline__ +#elif \ + JSON_HEDLEY_MSVC_VERSION_CHECK(12,0,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_CL_VERSION_CHECK(2021,1,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_ARM_VERSION_CHECK(4,1,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_ARMCL_VERSION_CHECK(5,1,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL430_VERSION_CHECK(3,1,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL2000_VERSION_CHECK(6,2,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL6X_VERSION_CHECK(8,0,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL7X_VERSION_CHECK(1,2,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CLPRU_VERSION_CHECK(2,1,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_MCST_LCC_VERSION_CHECK(1,25,10) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_INLINE __inline +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_INLINE +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_ALWAYS_INLINE) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_ALWAYS_INLINE +#endif +#if \ + JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_ATTRIBUTE(always_inline) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_VERSION_CHECK(4,0,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_VERSION_CHECK(13,0,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_SUNPRO_VERSION_CHECK(5,11,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_ARM_VERSION_CHECK(4,1,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_IBM_VERSION_CHECK(10,1,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_VERSION_CHECK(15,12,0) || \ + (JSON_HEDLEY_TI_ARMCL_VERSION_CHECK(4,8,0) && defined(__TI_GNU_ATTRIBUTE_SUPPORT__)) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_ARMCL_VERSION_CHECK(5,2,0) || \ + (JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL2000_VERSION_CHECK(6,0,0) && defined(__TI_GNU_ATTRIBUTE_SUPPORT__)) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL2000_VERSION_CHECK(6,4,0) || \ + (JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL430_VERSION_CHECK(4,0,0) && defined(__TI_GNU_ATTRIBUTE_SUPPORT__)) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL430_VERSION_CHECK(4,3,0) || \ + (JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL6X_VERSION_CHECK(7,2,0) && defined(__TI_GNU_ATTRIBUTE_SUPPORT__)) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL6X_VERSION_CHECK(7,5,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL7X_VERSION_CHECK(1,2,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CLPRU_VERSION_CHECK(2,1,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_MCST_LCC_VERSION_CHECK(1,25,10) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_IAR_VERSION_CHECK(8,10,0) +# define JSON_HEDLEY_ALWAYS_INLINE __attribute__((__always_inline__)) JSON_HEDLEY_INLINE +#elif \ + JSON_HEDLEY_MSVC_VERSION_CHECK(12,0,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_CL_VERSION_CHECK(2021,1,0) +# define JSON_HEDLEY_ALWAYS_INLINE __forceinline +#elif defined(__cplusplus) && \ + ( \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_ARMCL_VERSION_CHECK(5,2,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL430_VERSION_CHECK(4,3,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL2000_VERSION_CHECK(6,4,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL6X_VERSION_CHECK(6,1,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL7X_VERSION_CHECK(1,2,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CLPRU_VERSION_CHECK(2,1,0) \ + ) +# define JSON_HEDLEY_ALWAYS_INLINE _Pragma("FUNC_ALWAYS_INLINE;") +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_IAR_VERSION_CHECK(8,0,0) +# define JSON_HEDLEY_ALWAYS_INLINE _Pragma("inline=forced") +#else +# define JSON_HEDLEY_ALWAYS_INLINE JSON_HEDLEY_INLINE +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_NEVER_INLINE) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_NEVER_INLINE +#endif +#if \ + JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_ATTRIBUTE(noinline) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_VERSION_CHECK(4,0,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_VERSION_CHECK(13,0,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_SUNPRO_VERSION_CHECK(5,11,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_ARM_VERSION_CHECK(4,1,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_IBM_VERSION_CHECK(10,1,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_VERSION_CHECK(15,12,0) || \ + (JSON_HEDLEY_TI_ARMCL_VERSION_CHECK(4,8,0) && defined(__TI_GNU_ATTRIBUTE_SUPPORT__)) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_ARMCL_VERSION_CHECK(5,2,0) || \ + (JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL2000_VERSION_CHECK(6,0,0) && defined(__TI_GNU_ATTRIBUTE_SUPPORT__)) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL2000_VERSION_CHECK(6,4,0) || \ + (JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL430_VERSION_CHECK(4,0,0) && defined(__TI_GNU_ATTRIBUTE_SUPPORT__)) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL430_VERSION_CHECK(4,3,0) || \ + (JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL6X_VERSION_CHECK(7,2,0) && defined(__TI_GNU_ATTRIBUTE_SUPPORT__)) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL6X_VERSION_CHECK(7,5,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL7X_VERSION_CHECK(1,2,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CLPRU_VERSION_CHECK(2,1,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_MCST_LCC_VERSION_CHECK(1,25,10) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_IAR_VERSION_CHECK(8,10,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_NEVER_INLINE __attribute__((__noinline__)) +#elif \ + JSON_HEDLEY_MSVC_VERSION_CHECK(13,10,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_CL_VERSION_CHECK(2021,1,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_NEVER_INLINE __declspec(noinline) +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_PGI_VERSION_CHECK(10,2,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_NEVER_INLINE _Pragma("noinline") +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL6X_VERSION_CHECK(6,0,0) && defined(__cplusplus) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_NEVER_INLINE _Pragma("FUNC_CANNOT_INLINE;") +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_IAR_VERSION_CHECK(8,0,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_NEVER_INLINE _Pragma("inline=never") +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_COMPCERT_VERSION_CHECK(3,2,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_NEVER_INLINE __attribute((noinline)) +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_PELLES_VERSION_CHECK(9,0,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_NEVER_INLINE __declspec(noinline) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_NEVER_INLINE +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_PRIVATE) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_PRIVATE +#endif +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_PUBLIC) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_PUBLIC +#endif +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_IMPORT) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_IMPORT +#endif +#if defined(_WIN32) || defined(__CYGWIN__) +# define JSON_HEDLEY_PRIVATE +# define JSON_HEDLEY_PUBLIC __declspec(dllexport) +# define JSON_HEDLEY_IMPORT __declspec(dllimport) +#else +# if \ + JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_ATTRIBUTE(visibility) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_VERSION_CHECK(3,3,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_SUNPRO_VERSION_CHECK(5,11,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_VERSION_CHECK(13,0,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_ARM_VERSION_CHECK(4,1,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_IBM_VERSION_CHECK(13,1,0) || \ + ( \ + defined(__TI_EABI__) && \ + ( \ + (JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL6X_VERSION_CHECK(7,2,0) && defined(__TI_GNU_ATTRIBUTE_SUPPORT__)) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL6X_VERSION_CHECK(7,5,0) \ + ) \ + ) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_MCST_LCC_VERSION_CHECK(1,25,10) +# define JSON_HEDLEY_PRIVATE __attribute__((__visibility__("hidden"))) +# define JSON_HEDLEY_PUBLIC __attribute__((__visibility__("default"))) +# else +# define JSON_HEDLEY_PRIVATE +# define JSON_HEDLEY_PUBLIC +# endif +# define JSON_HEDLEY_IMPORT extern +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_NO_THROW) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_NO_THROW +#endif +#if \ + JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_ATTRIBUTE(nothrow) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_VERSION_CHECK(3,3,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_VERSION_CHECK(13,0,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_MCST_LCC_VERSION_CHECK(1,25,10) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_NO_THROW __attribute__((__nothrow__)) +#elif \ + JSON_HEDLEY_MSVC_VERSION_CHECK(13,1,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_CL_VERSION_CHECK(2021,1,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_ARM_VERSION_CHECK(4,1,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_NO_THROW __declspec(nothrow) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_NO_THROW +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_FALL_THROUGH) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_FALL_THROUGH +#endif +#if \ + JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_ATTRIBUTE(fallthrough) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_VERSION_CHECK(7,0,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_MCST_LCC_VERSION_CHECK(1,25,10) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_FALL_THROUGH __attribute__((__fallthrough__)) +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_CPP_ATTRIBUTE_NS(clang,fallthrough) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_FALL_THROUGH JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_CPP98_COMPAT_WRAP_([[clang::fallthrough]]) +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_CPP_ATTRIBUTE(fallthrough) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_FALL_THROUGH JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_CPP98_COMPAT_WRAP_([[fallthrough]]) +#elif defined(__fallthrough) /* SAL */ + #define JSON_HEDLEY_FALL_THROUGH __fallthrough +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_FALL_THROUGH +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_RETURNS_NON_NULL) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_RETURNS_NON_NULL +#endif +#if \ + JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_ATTRIBUTE(returns_nonnull) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_VERSION_CHECK(4,9,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_MCST_LCC_VERSION_CHECK(1,25,10) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_RETURNS_NON_NULL __attribute__((__returns_nonnull__)) +#elif defined(_Ret_notnull_) /* SAL */ + #define JSON_HEDLEY_RETURNS_NON_NULL _Ret_notnull_ +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_RETURNS_NON_NULL +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_ARRAY_PARAM) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_ARRAY_PARAM +#endif +#if \ + defined(__STDC_VERSION__) && (__STDC_VERSION__ >= 199901L) && \ + !defined(__STDC_NO_VLA__) && \ + !defined(__cplusplus) && \ + !defined(JSON_HEDLEY_PGI_VERSION) && \ + !defined(JSON_HEDLEY_TINYC_VERSION) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_ARRAY_PARAM(name) (name) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_ARRAY_PARAM(name) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_IS_CONSTANT) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_IS_CONSTANT +#endif +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_REQUIRE_CONSTEXPR) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_REQUIRE_CONSTEXPR +#endif +/* JSON_HEDLEY_IS_CONSTEXPR_ is for + HEDLEY INTERNAL USE ONLY. API subject to change without notice. */ +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_IS_CONSTEXPR_) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_IS_CONSTEXPR_ +#endif +#if \ + JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_BUILTIN(__builtin_constant_p) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_VERSION_CHECK(3,4,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_VERSION_CHECK(13,0,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TINYC_VERSION_CHECK(0,9,19) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_ARM_VERSION_CHECK(4,1,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_IBM_VERSION_CHECK(13,1,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL6X_VERSION_CHECK(6,1,0) || \ + (JSON_HEDLEY_SUNPRO_VERSION_CHECK(5,10,0) && !defined(__cplusplus)) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_CRAY_VERSION_CHECK(8,1,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_MCST_LCC_VERSION_CHECK(1,25,10) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_IS_CONSTANT(expr) __builtin_constant_p(expr) +#endif +#if !defined(__cplusplus) +# if \ + JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_BUILTIN(__builtin_types_compatible_p) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_VERSION_CHECK(3,4,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_VERSION_CHECK(13,0,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_IBM_VERSION_CHECK(13,1,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_CRAY_VERSION_CHECK(8,1,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_ARM_VERSION_CHECK(5,4,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TINYC_VERSION_CHECK(0,9,24) +#if defined(__INTPTR_TYPE__) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_IS_CONSTEXPR_(expr) __builtin_types_compatible_p(__typeof__((1 ? (void*) ((__INTPTR_TYPE__) ((expr) * 0)) : (int*) 0)), int*) +#else + #include + #define JSON_HEDLEY_IS_CONSTEXPR_(expr) __builtin_types_compatible_p(__typeof__((1 ? (void*) ((intptr_t) ((expr) * 0)) : (int*) 0)), int*) +#endif +# elif \ + ( \ + defined(__STDC_VERSION__) && (__STDC_VERSION__ >= 201112L) && \ + !defined(JSON_HEDLEY_SUNPRO_VERSION) && \ + !defined(JSON_HEDLEY_PGI_VERSION) && \ + !defined(JSON_HEDLEY_IAR_VERSION)) || \ + (JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_EXTENSION(c_generic_selections) && !defined(JSON_HEDLEY_IAR_VERSION)) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_VERSION_CHECK(4,9,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_VERSION_CHECK(17,0,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_IBM_VERSION_CHECK(12,1,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_ARM_VERSION_CHECK(5,3,0) +#if defined(__INTPTR_TYPE__) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_IS_CONSTEXPR_(expr) _Generic((1 ? (void*) ((__INTPTR_TYPE__) ((expr) * 0)) : (int*) 0), int*: 1, void*: 0) +#else + #include + #define JSON_HEDLEY_IS_CONSTEXPR_(expr) _Generic((1 ? (void*) ((intptr_t) * 0) : (int*) 0), int*: 1, void*: 0) +#endif +# elif \ + defined(JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_VERSION) || \ + defined(JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_VERSION) || \ + defined(JSON_HEDLEY_TINYC_VERSION) || \ + defined(JSON_HEDLEY_TI_ARMCL_VERSION) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL430_VERSION_CHECK(18,12,0) || \ + defined(JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL2000_VERSION) || \ + defined(JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL6X_VERSION) || \ + defined(JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL7X_VERSION) || \ + defined(JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CLPRU_VERSION) || \ + defined(__clang__) +# define JSON_HEDLEY_IS_CONSTEXPR_(expr) ( \ + sizeof(void) != \ + sizeof(*( \ + 1 ? \ + ((void*) ((expr) * 0L) ) : \ +((struct { char v[sizeof(void) * 2]; } *) 1) \ + ) \ + ) \ + ) +# endif +#endif +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_IS_CONSTEXPR_) + #if !defined(JSON_HEDLEY_IS_CONSTANT) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_IS_CONSTANT(expr) JSON_HEDLEY_IS_CONSTEXPR_(expr) + #endif + #define JSON_HEDLEY_REQUIRE_CONSTEXPR(expr) (JSON_HEDLEY_IS_CONSTEXPR_(expr) ? (expr) : (-1)) +#else + #if !defined(JSON_HEDLEY_IS_CONSTANT) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_IS_CONSTANT(expr) (0) + #endif + #define JSON_HEDLEY_REQUIRE_CONSTEXPR(expr) (expr) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_BEGIN_C_DECLS) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_BEGIN_C_DECLS +#endif +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_END_C_DECLS) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_END_C_DECLS +#endif +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_C_DECL) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_C_DECL +#endif +#if defined(__cplusplus) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_BEGIN_C_DECLS extern "C" { + #define JSON_HEDLEY_END_C_DECLS } + #define JSON_HEDLEY_C_DECL extern "C" +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_BEGIN_C_DECLS + #define JSON_HEDLEY_END_C_DECLS + #define JSON_HEDLEY_C_DECL +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_STATIC_ASSERT) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_STATIC_ASSERT +#endif +#if \ + !defined(__cplusplus) && ( \ + (defined(__STDC_VERSION__) && (__STDC_VERSION__ >= 201112L)) || \ + (JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_FEATURE(c_static_assert) && !defined(JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_CL_VERSION)) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_VERSION_CHECK(6,0,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_VERSION_CHECK(13,0,0) || \ + defined(_Static_assert) \ + ) +# define JSON_HEDLEY_STATIC_ASSERT(expr, message) _Static_assert(expr, message) +#elif \ + (defined(__cplusplus) && (__cplusplus >= 201103L)) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_MSVC_VERSION_CHECK(16,0,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_CL_VERSION_CHECK(2021,1,0) +# define JSON_HEDLEY_STATIC_ASSERT(expr, message) JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_CPP98_COMPAT_WRAP_(static_assert(expr, message)) +#else +# define JSON_HEDLEY_STATIC_ASSERT(expr, message) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_NULL) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_NULL +#endif +#if defined(__cplusplus) + #if __cplusplus >= 201103L + #define JSON_HEDLEY_NULL JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_CPP98_COMPAT_WRAP_(nullptr) + #elif defined(NULL) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_NULL NULL + #else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_NULL JSON_HEDLEY_STATIC_CAST(void*, 0) + #endif +#elif defined(NULL) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_NULL NULL +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_NULL ((void*) 0) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_MESSAGE) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_MESSAGE +#endif +#if JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_WARNING("-Wunknown-pragmas") +# define JSON_HEDLEY_MESSAGE(msg) \ + JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_PUSH \ + JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_UNKNOWN_PRAGMAS \ + JSON_HEDLEY_PRAGMA(message msg) \ + JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_POP +#elif \ + JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_VERSION_CHECK(4,4,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_VERSION_CHECK(13,0,0) +# define JSON_HEDLEY_MESSAGE(msg) JSON_HEDLEY_PRAGMA(message msg) +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_CRAY_VERSION_CHECK(5,0,0) +# define JSON_HEDLEY_MESSAGE(msg) JSON_HEDLEY_PRAGMA(_CRI message msg) +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_IAR_VERSION_CHECK(8,0,0) +# define JSON_HEDLEY_MESSAGE(msg) JSON_HEDLEY_PRAGMA(message(msg)) +#elif JSON_HEDLEY_PELLES_VERSION_CHECK(2,0,0) +# define JSON_HEDLEY_MESSAGE(msg) JSON_HEDLEY_PRAGMA(message(msg)) +#else +# define JSON_HEDLEY_MESSAGE(msg) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_WARNING) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_WARNING +#endif +#if JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_WARNING("-Wunknown-pragmas") +# define JSON_HEDLEY_WARNING(msg) \ + JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_PUSH \ + JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_UNKNOWN_PRAGMAS \ + JSON_HEDLEY_PRAGMA(clang warning msg) \ + JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_POP +#elif \ + JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_VERSION_CHECK(4,8,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_PGI_VERSION_CHECK(18,4,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_VERSION_CHECK(13,0,0) +# define JSON_HEDLEY_WARNING(msg) JSON_HEDLEY_PRAGMA(GCC warning msg) +#elif \ + JSON_HEDLEY_MSVC_VERSION_CHECK(15,0,0) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_CL_VERSION_CHECK(2021,1,0) +# define JSON_HEDLEY_WARNING(msg) JSON_HEDLEY_PRAGMA(message(msg)) +#else +# define JSON_HEDLEY_WARNING(msg) JSON_HEDLEY_MESSAGE(msg) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_REQUIRE) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_REQUIRE +#endif +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_REQUIRE_MSG) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_REQUIRE_MSG +#endif +#if JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_ATTRIBUTE(diagnose_if) +# if JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_WARNING("-Wgcc-compat") +# define JSON_HEDLEY_REQUIRE(expr) \ + JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_PUSH \ + _Pragma("clang diagnostic ignored \"-Wgcc-compat\"") \ + __attribute__((diagnose_if(!(expr), #expr, "error"))) \ + JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_POP +# define JSON_HEDLEY_REQUIRE_MSG(expr,msg) \ + JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_PUSH \ + _Pragma("clang diagnostic ignored \"-Wgcc-compat\"") \ + __attribute__((diagnose_if(!(expr), msg, "error"))) \ + JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_POP +# else +# define JSON_HEDLEY_REQUIRE(expr) __attribute__((diagnose_if(!(expr), #expr, "error"))) +# define JSON_HEDLEY_REQUIRE_MSG(expr,msg) __attribute__((diagnose_if(!(expr), msg, "error"))) +# endif +#else +# define JSON_HEDLEY_REQUIRE(expr) +# define JSON_HEDLEY_REQUIRE_MSG(expr,msg) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_FLAGS) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_FLAGS +#endif +#if JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_ATTRIBUTE(flag_enum) && (!defined(__cplusplus) || JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_WARNING("-Wbitfield-enum-conversion")) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_FLAGS __attribute__((__flag_enum__)) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_FLAGS +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_FLAGS_CAST) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_FLAGS_CAST +#endif +#if JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_VERSION_CHECK(19,0,0) +# define JSON_HEDLEY_FLAGS_CAST(T, expr) (__extension__ ({ \ + JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_PUSH \ + _Pragma("warning(disable:188)") \ + ((T) (expr)); \ + JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_POP \ + })) +#else +# define JSON_HEDLEY_FLAGS_CAST(T, expr) JSON_HEDLEY_STATIC_CAST(T, expr) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_EMPTY_BASES) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_EMPTY_BASES +#endif +#if \ + (JSON_HEDLEY_MSVC_VERSION_CHECK(19,0,23918) && !JSON_HEDLEY_MSVC_VERSION_CHECK(20,0,0)) || \ + JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_CL_VERSION_CHECK(2021,1,0) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_EMPTY_BASES __declspec(empty_bases) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_EMPTY_BASES +#endif + +/* Remaining macros are deprecated. */ + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_NOT_CLANG_VERSION_CHECK) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_NOT_CLANG_VERSION_CHECK +#endif +#if defined(__clang__) + #define JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_NOT_CLANG_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) (0) +#else + #define JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_NOT_CLANG_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_VERSION_CHECK(major,minor,patch) +#endif + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_CLANG_HAS_ATTRIBUTE) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_CLANG_HAS_ATTRIBUTE +#endif +#define JSON_HEDLEY_CLANG_HAS_ATTRIBUTE(attribute) JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_ATTRIBUTE(attribute) + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_CLANG_HAS_CPP_ATTRIBUTE) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_CLANG_HAS_CPP_ATTRIBUTE +#endif +#define JSON_HEDLEY_CLANG_HAS_CPP_ATTRIBUTE(attribute) JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_CPP_ATTRIBUTE(attribute) + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_CLANG_HAS_BUILTIN) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_CLANG_HAS_BUILTIN +#endif +#define JSON_HEDLEY_CLANG_HAS_BUILTIN(builtin) JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_BUILTIN(builtin) + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_CLANG_HAS_FEATURE) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_CLANG_HAS_FEATURE +#endif +#define JSON_HEDLEY_CLANG_HAS_FEATURE(feature) JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_FEATURE(feature) + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_CLANG_HAS_EXTENSION) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_CLANG_HAS_EXTENSION +#endif +#define JSON_HEDLEY_CLANG_HAS_EXTENSION(extension) JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_EXTENSION(extension) + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_CLANG_HAS_DECLSPEC_DECLSPEC_ATTRIBUTE) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_CLANG_HAS_DECLSPEC_DECLSPEC_ATTRIBUTE +#endif +#define JSON_HEDLEY_CLANG_HAS_DECLSPEC_ATTRIBUTE(attribute) JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_DECLSPEC_ATTRIBUTE(attribute) + +#if defined(JSON_HEDLEY_CLANG_HAS_WARNING) + #undef JSON_HEDLEY_CLANG_HAS_WARNING +#endif +#define JSON_HEDLEY_CLANG_HAS_WARNING(warning) JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_WARNING(warning) + +#endif /* !defined(JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION) || (JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION < X) */ + +// #include + + +#include + +// #include + + +namespace nlohmann +{ +namespace detail +{ +template struct make_void +{ + using type = void; +}; +template using void_t = typename make_void::type; +} // namespace detail +} // namespace nlohmann + + +// https://en.cppreference.com/w/cpp/experimental/is_detected +namespace nlohmann +{ +namespace detail +{ +struct nonesuch +{ + nonesuch() = delete; + ~nonesuch() = delete; + nonesuch(nonesuch const&) = delete; + nonesuch(nonesuch const&&) = delete; + void operator=(nonesuch const&) = delete; + void operator=(nonesuch&&) = delete; +}; + +template class Op, + class... Args> +struct detector +{ + using value_t = std::false_type; + using type = Default; +}; + +template class Op, class... Args> +struct detector>, Op, Args...> +{ + using value_t = std::true_type; + using type = Op; +}; + +template class Op, class... Args> +using is_detected = typename detector::value_t; + +template class Op, class... Args> +struct is_detected_lazy : is_detected { }; + +template class Op, class... Args> +using detected_t = typename detector::type; + +template class Op, class... Args> +using detected_or = detector; + +template class Op, class... Args> +using detected_or_t = typename detected_or::type; + +template class Op, class... Args> +using is_detected_exact = std::is_same>; + +template class Op, class... Args> +using is_detected_convertible = + std::is_convertible, To>; +} // namespace detail +} // namespace nlohmann + + +// This file contains all internal macro definitions +// You MUST include macro_unscope.hpp at the end of json.hpp to undef all of them + +// exclude unsupported compilers +#if !defined(JSON_SKIP_UNSUPPORTED_COMPILER_CHECK) + #if defined(__clang__) + #if (__clang_major__ * 10000 + __clang_minor__ * 100 + __clang_patchlevel__) < 30400 + #error "unsupported Clang version - see https://github.com/nlohmann/json#supported-compilers" + #endif + #elif defined(__GNUC__) && !(defined(__ICC) || defined(__INTEL_COMPILER)) + #if (__GNUC__ * 10000 + __GNUC_MINOR__ * 100 + __GNUC_PATCHLEVEL__) < 40800 + #error "unsupported GCC version - see https://github.com/nlohmann/json#supported-compilers" + #endif + #endif +#endif + +// C++ language standard detection +// if the user manually specified the used c++ version this is skipped +#if !defined(JSON_HAS_CPP_20) && !defined(JSON_HAS_CPP_17) && !defined(JSON_HAS_CPP_14) && !defined(JSON_HAS_CPP_11) + #if (defined(__cplusplus) && __cplusplus >= 202002L) || (defined(_MSVC_LANG) && _MSVC_LANG >= 202002L) + #define JSON_HAS_CPP_20 + #define JSON_HAS_CPP_17 + #define JSON_HAS_CPP_14 + #elif (defined(__cplusplus) && __cplusplus >= 201703L) || (defined(_HAS_CXX17) && _HAS_CXX17 == 1) // fix for issue #464 + #define JSON_HAS_CPP_17 + #define JSON_HAS_CPP_14 + #elif (defined(__cplusplus) && __cplusplus >= 201402L) || (defined(_HAS_CXX14) && _HAS_CXX14 == 1) + #define JSON_HAS_CPP_14 + #endif + // the cpp 11 flag is always specified because it is the minimal required version + #define JSON_HAS_CPP_11 +#endif + +#if !defined(JSON_HAS_FILESYSTEM) && !defined(JSON_HAS_EXPERIMENTAL_FILESYSTEM) + #ifdef JSON_HAS_CPP_17 + #if defined(__cpp_lib_filesystem) + #define JSON_HAS_FILESYSTEM 1 + #elif defined(__cpp_lib_experimental_filesystem) + #define JSON_HAS_EXPERIMENTAL_FILESYSTEM 1 + #elif !defined(__has_include) + #define JSON_HAS_EXPERIMENTAL_FILESYSTEM 1 + #elif __has_include() + #define JSON_HAS_FILESYSTEM 1 + #elif __has_include() + #define JSON_HAS_EXPERIMENTAL_FILESYSTEM 1 + #endif + + // std::filesystem does not work on MinGW GCC 8: https://sourceforge.net/p/mingw-w64/bugs/737/ + #if defined(__MINGW32__) && defined(__GNUC__) && __GNUC__ == 8 + #undef JSON_HAS_FILESYSTEM + #undef JSON_HAS_EXPERIMENTAL_FILESYSTEM + #endif + + // no filesystem support before GCC 8: https://en.cppreference.com/w/cpp/compiler_support + #if defined(__GNUC__) && !defined(__clang__) && __GNUC__ < 8 + #undef JSON_HAS_FILESYSTEM + #undef JSON_HAS_EXPERIMENTAL_FILESYSTEM + #endif + + // no filesystem support before Clang 7: https://en.cppreference.com/w/cpp/compiler_support + #if defined(__clang_major__) && __clang_major__ < 7 + #undef JSON_HAS_FILESYSTEM + #undef JSON_HAS_EXPERIMENTAL_FILESYSTEM + #endif + + // no filesystem support before MSVC 19.14: https://en.cppreference.com/w/cpp/compiler_support + #if defined(_MSC_VER) && _MSC_VER < 1914 + #undef JSON_HAS_FILESYSTEM + #undef JSON_HAS_EXPERIMENTAL_FILESYSTEM + #endif + + // no filesystem support before iOS 13 + #if defined(__IPHONE_OS_VERSION_MIN_REQUIRED) && __IPHONE_OS_VERSION_MIN_REQUIRED < 130000 + #undef JSON_HAS_FILESYSTEM + #undef JSON_HAS_EXPERIMENTAL_FILESYSTEM + #endif + + // no filesystem support before macOS Catalina + #if defined(__MAC_OS_X_VERSION_MIN_REQUIRED) && __MAC_OS_X_VERSION_MIN_REQUIRED < 101500 + #undef JSON_HAS_FILESYSTEM + #undef JSON_HAS_EXPERIMENTAL_FILESYSTEM + #endif + #endif +#endif + +#ifndef JSON_HAS_EXPERIMENTAL_FILESYSTEM + #define JSON_HAS_EXPERIMENTAL_FILESYSTEM 0 +#endif + +#ifndef JSON_HAS_FILESYSTEM + #define JSON_HAS_FILESYSTEM 0 +#endif + +// disable documentation warnings on clang +#if defined(__clang__) + #pragma clang diagnostic push + #pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wdocumentation" + #pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wdocumentation-unknown-command" +#endif + +// allow disabling exceptions +#if (defined(__cpp_exceptions) || defined(__EXCEPTIONS) || defined(_CPPUNWIND)) && !defined(JSON_NOEXCEPTION) + #define JSON_THROW(exception) throw exception + #define JSON_TRY try + #define JSON_CATCH(exception) catch(exception) + #define JSON_INTERNAL_CATCH(exception) catch(exception) +#else + #include + #define JSON_THROW(exception) std::abort() + #define JSON_TRY if(true) + #define JSON_CATCH(exception) if(false) + #define JSON_INTERNAL_CATCH(exception) if(false) +#endif + +// override exception macros +#if defined(JSON_THROW_USER) + #undef JSON_THROW + #define JSON_THROW JSON_THROW_USER +#endif +#if defined(JSON_TRY_USER) + #undef JSON_TRY + #define JSON_TRY JSON_TRY_USER +#endif +#if defined(JSON_CATCH_USER) + #undef JSON_CATCH + #define JSON_CATCH JSON_CATCH_USER + #undef JSON_INTERNAL_CATCH + #define JSON_INTERNAL_CATCH JSON_CATCH_USER +#endif +#if defined(JSON_INTERNAL_CATCH_USER) + #undef JSON_INTERNAL_CATCH + #define JSON_INTERNAL_CATCH JSON_INTERNAL_CATCH_USER +#endif + +// allow overriding assert +#if !defined(JSON_ASSERT) + #include // assert + #define JSON_ASSERT(x) assert(x) +#endif + +// allow to access some private functions (needed by the test suite) +#if defined(JSON_TESTS_PRIVATE) + #define JSON_PRIVATE_UNLESS_TESTED public +#else + #define JSON_PRIVATE_UNLESS_TESTED private +#endif + +/*! +@brief macro to briefly define a mapping between an enum and JSON +@def NLOHMANN_JSON_SERIALIZE_ENUM +@since version 3.4.0 +*/ +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_SERIALIZE_ENUM(ENUM_TYPE, ...) \ + template \ + inline void to_json(BasicJsonType& j, const ENUM_TYPE& e) \ + { \ + static_assert(std::is_enum::value, #ENUM_TYPE " must be an enum!"); \ + static const std::pair m[] = __VA_ARGS__; \ + auto it = std::find_if(std::begin(m), std::end(m), \ + [e](const std::pair& ej_pair) -> bool \ + { \ + return ej_pair.first == e; \ + }); \ + j = ((it != std::end(m)) ? it : std::begin(m))->second; \ + } \ + template \ + inline void from_json(const BasicJsonType& j, ENUM_TYPE& e) \ + { \ + static_assert(std::is_enum::value, #ENUM_TYPE " must be an enum!"); \ + static const std::pair m[] = __VA_ARGS__; \ + auto it = std::find_if(std::begin(m), std::end(m), \ + [&j](const std::pair& ej_pair) -> bool \ + { \ + return ej_pair.second == j; \ + }); \ + e = ((it != std::end(m)) ? it : std::begin(m))->first; \ + } + +// Ugly macros to avoid uglier copy-paste when specializing basic_json. They +// may be removed in the future once the class is split. + +#define NLOHMANN_BASIC_JSON_TPL_DECLARATION \ + template class ObjectType, \ + template class ArrayType, \ + class StringType, class BooleanType, class NumberIntegerType, \ + class NumberUnsignedType, class NumberFloatType, \ + template class AllocatorType, \ + template class JSONSerializer, \ + class BinaryType> + +#define NLOHMANN_BASIC_JSON_TPL \ + basic_json + +// Macros to simplify conversion from/to types + +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_EXPAND( x ) x +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_GET_MACRO(_1, _2, _3, _4, _5, _6, _7, _8, _9, _10, _11, _12, _13, _14, _15, _16, _17, _18, _19, _20, _21, _22, _23, _24, _25, _26, _27, _28, _29, _30, _31, _32, _33, _34, _35, _36, _37, _38, _39, _40, _41, _42, _43, _44, _45, _46, _47, _48, _49, _50, _51, _52, _53, _54, _55, _56, _57, _58, _59, _60, _61, _62, _63, _64, NAME,...) NAME +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE(...) NLOHMANN_JSON_EXPAND(NLOHMANN_JSON_GET_MACRO(__VA_ARGS__, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE64, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE63, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE62, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE61, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE60, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE59, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE58, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE57, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE56, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE55, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE54, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE53, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE52, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE51, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE50, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE49, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE48, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE47, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE46, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE45, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE44, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE43, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE42, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE41, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE40, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE39, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE38, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE37, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE36, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE35, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE34, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE33, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE32, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE31, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE30, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE29, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE28, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE27, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE26, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE25, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE24, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE23, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE22, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE21, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE20, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE19, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE18, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE17, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE16, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE15, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE14, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE13, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE12, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE11, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE10, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE9, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE8, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE7, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE6, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE5, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE4, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE3, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2, \ + NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE1)(__VA_ARGS__)) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) func(v1) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE3(func, v1, v2) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v2) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE4(func, v1, v2, v3) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE3(func, v2, v3) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE5(func, v1, v2, v3, v4) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE4(func, v2, v3, v4) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE6(func, v1, v2, v3, v4, v5) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE5(func, v2, v3, v4, v5) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE7(func, v1, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE6(func, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE8(func, v1, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE7(func, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE9(func, v1, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE8(func, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE10(func, v1, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE9(func, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE11(func, v1, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE10(func, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE12(func, v1, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE11(func, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE13(func, v1, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE12(func, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE14(func, v1, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE13(func, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE15(func, v1, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE14(func, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE16(func, v1, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE15(func, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE17(func, v1, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE16(func, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE18(func, v1, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE17(func, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE19(func, v1, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE18(func, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE20(func, v1, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE19(func, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE21(func, v1, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE20(func, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE22(func, v1, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE21(func, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE23(func, v1, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE22(func, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE24(func, v1, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE23(func, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE25(func, v1, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE24(func, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE26(func, v1, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE25(func, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE27(func, v1, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE26(func, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE28(func, v1, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE27(func, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE29(func, v1, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE28(func, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE30(func, v1, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE29(func, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE31(func, v1, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE30(func, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE32(func, v1, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE31(func, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE33(func, v1, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE32(func, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE34(func, v1, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE33(func, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE35(func, v1, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE34(func, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE36(func, v1, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34, v35) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE35(func, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34, v35) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE37(func, v1, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34, v35, v36) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE36(func, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34, v35, v36) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE38(func, v1, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34, v35, v36, v37) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE37(func, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34, v35, v36, v37) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE39(func, v1, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34, v35, v36, v37, v38) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE38(func, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34, v35, v36, v37, v38) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE40(func, v1, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34, v35, v36, v37, v38, v39) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE39(func, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34, v35, v36, v37, v38, v39) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE41(func, v1, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34, v35, v36, v37, v38, v39, v40) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE40(func, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34, v35, v36, v37, v38, v39, v40) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE42(func, v1, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34, v35, v36, v37, v38, v39, v40, v41) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE41(func, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34, v35, v36, v37, v38, v39, v40, v41) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE43(func, v1, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34, v35, v36, v37, v38, v39, v40, v41, v42) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE42(func, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34, v35, v36, v37, v38, v39, v40, v41, v42) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE44(func, v1, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34, v35, v36, v37, v38, v39, v40, v41, v42, v43) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE43(func, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34, v35, v36, v37, v38, v39, v40, v41, v42, v43) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE45(func, v1, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34, v35, v36, v37, v38, v39, v40, v41, v42, v43, v44) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE44(func, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34, v35, v36, v37, v38, v39, v40, v41, v42, v43, v44) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE46(func, v1, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34, v35, v36, v37, v38, v39, v40, v41, v42, v43, v44, v45) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE45(func, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34, v35, v36, v37, v38, v39, v40, v41, v42, v43, v44, v45) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE47(func, v1, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34, v35, v36, v37, v38, v39, v40, v41, v42, v43, v44, v45, v46) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE46(func, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34, v35, v36, v37, v38, v39, v40, v41, v42, v43, v44, v45, v46) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE48(func, v1, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34, v35, v36, v37, v38, v39, v40, v41, v42, v43, v44, v45, v46, v47) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE47(func, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34, v35, v36, v37, v38, v39, v40, v41, v42, v43, v44, v45, v46, v47) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE49(func, v1, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34, v35, v36, v37, v38, v39, v40, v41, v42, v43, v44, v45, v46, v47, v48) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE48(func, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34, v35, v36, v37, v38, v39, v40, v41, v42, v43, v44, v45, v46, v47, v48) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE50(func, v1, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34, v35, v36, v37, v38, v39, v40, v41, v42, v43, v44, v45, v46, v47, v48, v49) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE49(func, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34, v35, v36, v37, v38, v39, v40, v41, v42, v43, v44, v45, v46, v47, v48, v49) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE51(func, v1, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34, v35, v36, v37, v38, v39, v40, v41, v42, v43, v44, v45, v46, v47, v48, v49, v50) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE50(func, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34, v35, v36, v37, v38, v39, v40, v41, v42, v43, v44, v45, v46, v47, v48, v49, v50) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE52(func, v1, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34, v35, v36, v37, v38, v39, v40, v41, v42, v43, v44, v45, v46, v47, v48, v49, v50, v51) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE51(func, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34, v35, v36, v37, v38, v39, v40, v41, v42, v43, v44, v45, v46, v47, v48, v49, v50, v51) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE53(func, v1, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34, v35, v36, v37, v38, v39, v40, v41, v42, v43, v44, v45, v46, v47, v48, v49, v50, v51, v52) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE52(func, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34, v35, v36, v37, v38, v39, v40, v41, v42, v43, v44, v45, v46, v47, v48, v49, v50, v51, v52) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE54(func, v1, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34, v35, v36, v37, v38, v39, v40, v41, v42, v43, v44, v45, v46, v47, v48, v49, v50, v51, v52, v53) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE53(func, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34, v35, v36, v37, v38, v39, v40, v41, v42, v43, v44, v45, v46, v47, v48, v49, v50, v51, v52, v53) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE55(func, v1, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34, v35, v36, v37, v38, v39, v40, v41, v42, v43, v44, v45, v46, v47, v48, v49, v50, v51, v52, v53, v54) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE54(func, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34, v35, v36, v37, v38, v39, v40, v41, v42, v43, v44, v45, v46, v47, v48, v49, v50, v51, v52, v53, v54) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE56(func, v1, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34, v35, v36, v37, v38, v39, v40, v41, v42, v43, v44, v45, v46, v47, v48, v49, v50, v51, v52, v53, v54, v55) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE55(func, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34, v35, v36, v37, v38, v39, v40, v41, v42, v43, v44, v45, v46, v47, v48, v49, v50, v51, v52, v53, v54, v55) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE57(func, v1, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34, v35, v36, v37, v38, v39, v40, v41, v42, v43, v44, v45, v46, v47, v48, v49, v50, v51, v52, v53, v54, v55, v56) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE56(func, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34, v35, v36, v37, v38, v39, v40, v41, v42, v43, v44, v45, v46, v47, v48, v49, v50, v51, v52, v53, v54, v55, v56) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE58(func, v1, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34, v35, v36, v37, v38, v39, v40, v41, v42, v43, v44, v45, v46, v47, v48, v49, v50, v51, v52, v53, v54, v55, v56, v57) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE57(func, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34, v35, v36, v37, v38, v39, v40, v41, v42, v43, v44, v45, v46, v47, v48, v49, v50, v51, v52, v53, v54, v55, v56, v57) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE59(func, v1, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34, v35, v36, v37, v38, v39, v40, v41, v42, v43, v44, v45, v46, v47, v48, v49, v50, v51, v52, v53, v54, v55, v56, v57, v58) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE58(func, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34, v35, v36, v37, v38, v39, v40, v41, v42, v43, v44, v45, v46, v47, v48, v49, v50, v51, v52, v53, v54, v55, v56, v57, v58) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE60(func, v1, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34, v35, v36, v37, v38, v39, v40, v41, v42, v43, v44, v45, v46, v47, v48, v49, v50, v51, v52, v53, v54, v55, v56, v57, v58, v59) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE59(func, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34, v35, v36, v37, v38, v39, v40, v41, v42, v43, v44, v45, v46, v47, v48, v49, v50, v51, v52, v53, v54, v55, v56, v57, v58, v59) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE61(func, v1, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34, v35, v36, v37, v38, v39, v40, v41, v42, v43, v44, v45, v46, v47, v48, v49, v50, v51, v52, v53, v54, v55, v56, v57, v58, v59, v60) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE60(func, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34, v35, v36, v37, v38, v39, v40, v41, v42, v43, v44, v45, v46, v47, v48, v49, v50, v51, v52, v53, v54, v55, v56, v57, v58, v59, v60) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE62(func, v1, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34, v35, v36, v37, v38, v39, v40, v41, v42, v43, v44, v45, v46, v47, v48, v49, v50, v51, v52, v53, v54, v55, v56, v57, v58, v59, v60, v61) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE61(func, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34, v35, v36, v37, v38, v39, v40, v41, v42, v43, v44, v45, v46, v47, v48, v49, v50, v51, v52, v53, v54, v55, v56, v57, v58, v59, v60, v61) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE63(func, v1, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34, v35, v36, v37, v38, v39, v40, v41, v42, v43, v44, v45, v46, v47, v48, v49, v50, v51, v52, v53, v54, v55, v56, v57, v58, v59, v60, v61, v62) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE62(func, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34, v35, v36, v37, v38, v39, v40, v41, v42, v43, v44, v45, v46, v47, v48, v49, v50, v51, v52, v53, v54, v55, v56, v57, v58, v59, v60, v61, v62) +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE64(func, v1, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34, v35, v36, v37, v38, v39, v40, v41, v42, v43, v44, v45, v46, v47, v48, v49, v50, v51, v52, v53, v54, v55, v56, v57, v58, v59, v60, v61, v62, v63) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE2(func, v1) NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE63(func, v2, v3, v4, v5, v6, v7, v8, v9, v10, v11, v12, v13, v14, v15, v16, v17, v18, v19, v20, v21, v22, v23, v24, v25, v26, v27, v28, v29, v30, v31, v32, v33, v34, v35, v36, v37, v38, v39, v40, v41, v42, v43, v44, v45, v46, v47, v48, v49, v50, v51, v52, v53, v54, v55, v56, v57, v58, v59, v60, v61, v62, v63) + +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_TO(v1) nlohmann_json_j[#v1] = nlohmann_json_t.v1; +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_FROM(v1) nlohmann_json_j.at(#v1).get_to(nlohmann_json_t.v1); +#define NLOHMANN_JSON_FROM_WITH_DEFAULT(v1) nlohmann_json_t.v1 = nlohmann_json_j.value(#v1, nlohmann_json_default_obj.v1); + +/*! +@brief macro +@def NLOHMANN_DEFINE_TYPE_INTRUSIVE +@since version 3.9.0 +*/ +#define NLOHMANN_DEFINE_TYPE_INTRUSIVE(Type, ...) \ + friend void to_json(nlohmann::json& nlohmann_json_j, const Type& nlohmann_json_t) { NLOHMANN_JSON_EXPAND(NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE(NLOHMANN_JSON_TO, __VA_ARGS__)) } \ + friend void from_json(const nlohmann::json& nlohmann_json_j, Type& nlohmann_json_t) { NLOHMANN_JSON_EXPAND(NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE(NLOHMANN_JSON_FROM, __VA_ARGS__)) } + +#define NLOHMANN_DEFINE_TYPE_INTRUSIVE_WITH_DEFAULT(Type, ...) \ + friend void to_json(nlohmann::json& nlohmann_json_j, const Type& nlohmann_json_t) { NLOHMANN_JSON_EXPAND(NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE(NLOHMANN_JSON_TO, __VA_ARGS__)) } \ + friend void from_json(const nlohmann::json& nlohmann_json_j, Type& nlohmann_json_t) { Type nlohmann_json_default_obj; NLOHMANN_JSON_EXPAND(NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE(NLOHMANN_JSON_FROM_WITH_DEFAULT, __VA_ARGS__)) } + +/*! +@brief macro +@def NLOHMANN_DEFINE_TYPE_NON_INTRUSIVE +@since version 3.9.0 +*/ +#define NLOHMANN_DEFINE_TYPE_NON_INTRUSIVE(Type, ...) \ + inline void to_json(nlohmann::json& nlohmann_json_j, const Type& nlohmann_json_t) { NLOHMANN_JSON_EXPAND(NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE(NLOHMANN_JSON_TO, __VA_ARGS__)) } \ + inline void from_json(const nlohmann::json& nlohmann_json_j, Type& nlohmann_json_t) { NLOHMANN_JSON_EXPAND(NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE(NLOHMANN_JSON_FROM, __VA_ARGS__)) } + +#define NLOHMANN_DEFINE_TYPE_NON_INTRUSIVE_WITH_DEFAULT(Type, ...) \ + inline void to_json(nlohmann::json& nlohmann_json_j, const Type& nlohmann_json_t) { NLOHMANN_JSON_EXPAND(NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE(NLOHMANN_JSON_TO, __VA_ARGS__)) } \ + inline void from_json(const nlohmann::json& nlohmann_json_j, Type& nlohmann_json_t) { Type nlohmann_json_default_obj; NLOHMANN_JSON_EXPAND(NLOHMANN_JSON_PASTE(NLOHMANN_JSON_FROM_WITH_DEFAULT, __VA_ARGS__)) } + + +// inspired from https://stackoverflow.com/a/26745591 +// allows to call any std function as if (e.g. with begin): +// using std::begin; begin(x); +// +// it allows using the detected idiom to retrieve the return type +// of such an expression +#define NLOHMANN_CAN_CALL_STD_FUNC_IMPL(std_name) \ + namespace detail { \ + using std::std_name; \ + \ + template \ + using result_of_##std_name = decltype(std_name(std::declval()...)); \ + } \ + \ + namespace detail2 { \ + struct std_name##_tag \ + { \ + }; \ + \ + template \ + std_name##_tag std_name(T&&...); \ + \ + template \ + using result_of_##std_name = decltype(std_name(std::declval()...)); \ + \ + template \ + struct would_call_std_##std_name \ + { \ + static constexpr auto const value = ::nlohmann::detail:: \ + is_detected_exact::value; \ + }; \ + } /* namespace detail2 */ \ + \ + template \ + struct would_call_std_##std_name : detail2::would_call_std_##std_name \ + { \ + } + +#ifndef JSON_USE_IMPLICIT_CONVERSIONS + #define JSON_USE_IMPLICIT_CONVERSIONS 1 +#endif + +#if JSON_USE_IMPLICIT_CONVERSIONS + #define JSON_EXPLICIT +#else + #define JSON_EXPLICIT explicit +#endif + +#ifndef JSON_DIAGNOSTICS + #define JSON_DIAGNOSTICS 0 +#endif + + +namespace nlohmann +{ +namespace detail +{ + +/*! +@brief replace all occurrences of a substring by another string + +@param[in,out] s the string to manipulate; changed so that all + occurrences of @a f are replaced with @a t +@param[in] f the substring to replace with @a t +@param[in] t the string to replace @a f + +@pre The search string @a f must not be empty. **This precondition is +enforced with an assertion.** + +@since version 2.0.0 +*/ +inline void replace_substring(std::string& s, const std::string& f, + const std::string& t) +{ + JSON_ASSERT(!f.empty()); + for (auto pos = s.find(f); // find first occurrence of f + pos != std::string::npos; // make sure f was found + s.replace(pos, f.size(), t), // replace with t, and + pos = s.find(f, pos + t.size())) // find next occurrence of f + {} +} + +/*! + * @brief string escaping as described in RFC 6901 (Sect. 4) + * @param[in] s string to escape + * @return escaped string + * + * Note the order of escaping "~" to "~0" and "/" to "~1" is important. + */ +inline std::string escape(std::string s) +{ + replace_substring(s, "~", "~0"); + replace_substring(s, "/", "~1"); + return s; +} + +/*! + * @brief string unescaping as described in RFC 6901 (Sect. 4) + * @param[in] s string to unescape + * @return unescaped string + * + * Note the order of escaping "~1" to "/" and "~0" to "~" is important. + */ +static void unescape(std::string& s) +{ + replace_substring(s, "~1", "/"); + replace_substring(s, "~0", "~"); +} + +} // namespace detail +} // namespace nlohmann + +// #include + + +#include // size_t + +namespace nlohmann +{ +namespace detail +{ +/// struct to capture the start position of the current token +struct position_t +{ + /// the total number of characters read + std::size_t chars_read_total = 0; + /// the number of characters read in the current line + std::size_t chars_read_current_line = 0; + /// the number of lines read + std::size_t lines_read = 0; + + /// conversion to size_t to preserve SAX interface + constexpr operator size_t() const + { + return chars_read_total; + } +}; + +} // namespace detail +} // namespace nlohmann + +// #include + + +namespace nlohmann +{ +namespace detail +{ +//////////////// +// exceptions // +//////////////// + +/// @brief general exception of the @ref basic_json class +/// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/exception/ +class exception : public std::exception +{ + public: + /// returns the explanatory string + const char* what() const noexcept override + { + return m.what(); + } + + /// the id of the exception + const int id; // NOLINT(cppcoreguidelines-non-private-member-variables-in-classes) + + protected: + JSON_HEDLEY_NON_NULL(3) + exception(int id_, const char* what_arg) : id(id_), m(what_arg) {} // NOLINT(bugprone-throw-keyword-missing) + + static std::string name(const std::string& ename, int id_) + { + return "[json.exception." + ename + "." + std::to_string(id_) + "] "; + } + + template + static std::string diagnostics(const BasicJsonType& leaf_element) + { +#if JSON_DIAGNOSTICS + std::vector tokens; + for (const auto* current = &leaf_element; current->m_parent != nullptr; current = current->m_parent) + { + switch (current->m_parent->type()) + { + case value_t::array: + { + for (std::size_t i = 0; i < current->m_parent->m_value.array->size(); ++i) + { + if (¤t->m_parent->m_value.array->operator[](i) == current) + { + tokens.emplace_back(std::to_string(i)); + break; + } + } + break; + } + + case value_t::object: + { + for (const auto& element : *current->m_parent->m_value.object) + { + if (&element.second == current) + { + tokens.emplace_back(element.first.c_str()); + break; + } + } + break; + } + + case value_t::null: // LCOV_EXCL_LINE + case value_t::string: // LCOV_EXCL_LINE + case value_t::boolean: // LCOV_EXCL_LINE + case value_t::number_integer: // LCOV_EXCL_LINE + case value_t::number_unsigned: // LCOV_EXCL_LINE + case value_t::number_float: // LCOV_EXCL_LINE + case value_t::binary: // LCOV_EXCL_LINE + case value_t::discarded: // LCOV_EXCL_LINE + default: // LCOV_EXCL_LINE + break; // LCOV_EXCL_LINE + } + } + + if (tokens.empty()) + { + return ""; + } + + return "(" + std::accumulate(tokens.rbegin(), tokens.rend(), std::string{}, + [](const std::string & a, const std::string & b) + { + return a + "/" + detail::escape(b); + }) + ") "; +#else + static_cast(leaf_element); + return ""; +#endif + } + + private: + /// an exception object as storage for error messages + std::runtime_error m; +}; + +/// @brief exception indicating a parse error +/// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/parse_error/ +class parse_error : public exception +{ + public: + /*! + @brief create a parse error exception + @param[in] id_ the id of the exception + @param[in] pos the position where the error occurred (or with + chars_read_total=0 if the position cannot be + determined) + @param[in] what_arg the explanatory string + @return parse_error object + */ + template + static parse_error create(int id_, const position_t& pos, const std::string& what_arg, const BasicJsonType& context) + { + std::string w = exception::name("parse_error", id_) + "parse error" + + position_string(pos) + ": " + exception::diagnostics(context) + what_arg; + return {id_, pos.chars_read_total, w.c_str()}; + } + + template + static parse_error create(int id_, std::size_t byte_, const std::string& what_arg, const BasicJsonType& context) + { + std::string w = exception::name("parse_error", id_) + "parse error" + + (byte_ != 0 ? (" at byte " + std::to_string(byte_)) : "") + + ": " + exception::diagnostics(context) + what_arg; + return {id_, byte_, w.c_str()}; + } + + /*! + @brief byte index of the parse error + + The byte index of the last read character in the input file. + + @note For an input with n bytes, 1 is the index of the first character and + n+1 is the index of the terminating null byte or the end of file. + This also holds true when reading a byte vector (CBOR or MessagePack). + */ + const std::size_t byte; + + private: + parse_error(int id_, std::size_t byte_, const char* what_arg) + : exception(id_, what_arg), byte(byte_) {} + + static std::string position_string(const position_t& pos) + { + return " at line " + std::to_string(pos.lines_read + 1) + + ", column " + std::to_string(pos.chars_read_current_line); + } +}; + +/// @brief exception indicating errors with iterators +/// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/invalid_iterator/ +class invalid_iterator : public exception +{ + public: + template + static invalid_iterator create(int id_, const std::string& what_arg, const BasicJsonType& context) + { + std::string w = exception::name("invalid_iterator", id_) + exception::diagnostics(context) + what_arg; + return {id_, w.c_str()}; + } + + private: + JSON_HEDLEY_NON_NULL(3) + invalid_iterator(int id_, const char* what_arg) + : exception(id_, what_arg) {} +}; + +/// @brief exception indicating executing a member function with a wrong type +/// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/type_error/ +class type_error : public exception +{ + public: + template + static type_error create(int id_, const std::string& what_arg, const BasicJsonType& context) + { + std::string w = exception::name("type_error", id_) + exception::diagnostics(context) + what_arg; + return {id_, w.c_str()}; + } + + private: + JSON_HEDLEY_NON_NULL(3) + type_error(int id_, const char* what_arg) : exception(id_, what_arg) {} +}; + +/// @brief exception indicating access out of the defined range +/// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/out_of_range/ +class out_of_range : public exception +{ + public: + template + static out_of_range create(int id_, const std::string& what_arg, const BasicJsonType& context) + { + std::string w = exception::name("out_of_range", id_) + exception::diagnostics(context) + what_arg; + return {id_, w.c_str()}; + } + + private: + JSON_HEDLEY_NON_NULL(3) + out_of_range(int id_, const char* what_arg) : exception(id_, what_arg) {} +}; + +/// @brief exception indicating other library errors +/// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/other_error/ +class other_error : public exception +{ + public: + template + static other_error create(int id_, const std::string& what_arg, const BasicJsonType& context) + { + std::string w = exception::name("other_error", id_) + exception::diagnostics(context) + what_arg; + return {id_, w.c_str()}; + } + + private: + JSON_HEDLEY_NON_NULL(3) + other_error(int id_, const char* what_arg) : exception(id_, what_arg) {} +}; + +} // namespace detail +} // namespace nlohmann + +// #include + +// #include + + +#include // size_t +#include // conditional, enable_if, false_type, integral_constant, is_constructible, is_integral, is_same, remove_cv, remove_reference, true_type +#include // index_sequence, make_index_sequence, index_sequence_for + +// #include + + +namespace nlohmann +{ +namespace detail +{ + +template +using uncvref_t = typename std::remove_cv::type>::type; + +#ifdef JSON_HAS_CPP_14 + +// the following utilities are natively available in C++14 +using std::enable_if_t; +using std::index_sequence; +using std::make_index_sequence; +using std::index_sequence_for; + +#else + +// alias templates to reduce boilerplate +template +using enable_if_t = typename std::enable_if::type; + +// The following code is taken from https://github.com/abseil/abseil-cpp/blob/10cb35e459f5ecca5b2ff107635da0bfa41011b4/absl/utility/utility.h +// which is part of Google Abseil (https://github.com/abseil/abseil-cpp), licensed under the Apache License 2.0. + +//// START OF CODE FROM GOOGLE ABSEIL + +// integer_sequence +// +// Class template representing a compile-time integer sequence. An instantiation +// of `integer_sequence` has a sequence of integers encoded in its +// type through its template arguments (which is a common need when +// working with C++11 variadic templates). `absl::integer_sequence` is designed +// to be a drop-in replacement for C++14's `std::integer_sequence`. +// +// Example: +// +// template< class T, T... Ints > +// void user_function(integer_sequence); +// +// int main() +// { +// // user_function's `T` will be deduced to `int` and `Ints...` +// // will be deduced to `0, 1, 2, 3, 4`. +// user_function(make_integer_sequence()); +// } +template +struct integer_sequence +{ + using value_type = T; + static constexpr std::size_t size() noexcept + { + return sizeof...(Ints); + } +}; + +// index_sequence +// +// A helper template for an `integer_sequence` of `size_t`, +// `absl::index_sequence` is designed to be a drop-in replacement for C++14's +// `std::index_sequence`. +template +using index_sequence = integer_sequence; + +namespace utility_internal +{ + +template +struct Extend; + +// Note that SeqSize == sizeof...(Ints). It's passed explicitly for efficiency. +template +struct Extend, SeqSize, 0> +{ + using type = integer_sequence < T, Ints..., (Ints + SeqSize)... >; +}; + +template +struct Extend, SeqSize, 1> +{ + using type = integer_sequence < T, Ints..., (Ints + SeqSize)..., 2 * SeqSize >; +}; + +// Recursion helper for 'make_integer_sequence'. +// 'Gen::type' is an alias for 'integer_sequence'. +template +struct Gen +{ + using type = + typename Extend < typename Gen < T, N / 2 >::type, N / 2, N % 2 >::type; +}; + +template +struct Gen +{ + using type = integer_sequence; +}; + +} // namespace utility_internal + +// Compile-time sequences of integers + +// make_integer_sequence +// +// This template alias is equivalent to +// `integer_sequence`, and is designed to be a drop-in +// replacement for C++14's `std::make_integer_sequence`. +template +using make_integer_sequence = typename utility_internal::Gen::type; + +// make_index_sequence +// +// This template alias is equivalent to `index_sequence<0, 1, ..., N-1>`, +// and is designed to be a drop-in replacement for C++14's +// `std::make_index_sequence`. +template +using make_index_sequence = make_integer_sequence; + +// index_sequence_for +// +// Converts a typename pack into an index sequence of the same length, and +// is designed to be a drop-in replacement for C++14's +// `std::index_sequence_for()` +template +using index_sequence_for = make_index_sequence; + +//// END OF CODE FROM GOOGLE ABSEIL + +#endif + +// dispatch utility (taken from ranges-v3) +template struct priority_tag : priority_tag < N - 1 > {}; +template<> struct priority_tag<0> {}; + +// taken from ranges-v3 +template +struct static_const +{ + static constexpr T value{}; +}; + +template +constexpr T static_const::value; // NOLINT(readability-redundant-declaration) + +} // namespace detail +} // namespace nlohmann + +// #include + + +namespace nlohmann +{ +namespace detail +{ +// dispatching helper struct +template struct identity_tag {}; +} // namespace detail +} // namespace nlohmann + +// #include + + +#include // numeric_limits +#include // false_type, is_constructible, is_integral, is_same, true_type +#include // declval +#include // tuple + +// #include + + +// #include + + +#include // random_access_iterator_tag + +// #include + +// #include + + +namespace nlohmann +{ +namespace detail +{ +template +struct iterator_types {}; + +template +struct iterator_types < + It, + void_t> +{ + using difference_type = typename It::difference_type; + using value_type = typename It::value_type; + using pointer = typename It::pointer; + using reference = typename It::reference; + using iterator_category = typename It::iterator_category; +}; + +// This is required as some compilers implement std::iterator_traits in a way that +// doesn't work with SFINAE. See https://github.com/nlohmann/json/issues/1341. +template +struct iterator_traits +{ +}; + +template +struct iterator_traits < T, enable_if_t < !std::is_pointer::value >> + : iterator_types +{ +}; + +template +struct iterator_traits::value>> +{ + using iterator_category = std::random_access_iterator_tag; + using value_type = T; + using difference_type = ptrdiff_t; + using pointer = T*; + using reference = T&; +}; +} // namespace detail +} // namespace nlohmann + +// #include + + +// #include + + +namespace nlohmann +{ +NLOHMANN_CAN_CALL_STD_FUNC_IMPL(begin); +} // namespace nlohmann + +// #include + + +// #include + + +namespace nlohmann +{ +NLOHMANN_CAN_CALL_STD_FUNC_IMPL(end); +} // namespace nlohmann + +// #include + +// #include + +// #include +#ifndef INCLUDE_NLOHMANN_JSON_FWD_HPP_ +#define INCLUDE_NLOHMANN_JSON_FWD_HPP_ + +#include // int64_t, uint64_t +#include // map +#include // allocator +#include // string +#include // vector + +/*! +@brief namespace for Niels Lohmann +@see https://github.com/nlohmann +@since version 1.0.0 +*/ +namespace nlohmann +{ +/*! +@brief default JSONSerializer template argument + +This serializer ignores the template arguments and uses ADL +([argument-dependent lookup](https://en.cppreference.com/w/cpp/language/adl)) +for serialization. +*/ +template +struct adl_serializer; + +/// a class to store JSON values +/// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/ +template class ObjectType = + std::map, + template class ArrayType = std::vector, + class StringType = std::string, class BooleanType = bool, + class NumberIntegerType = std::int64_t, + class NumberUnsignedType = std::uint64_t, + class NumberFloatType = double, + template class AllocatorType = std::allocator, + template class JSONSerializer = + adl_serializer, + class BinaryType = std::vector> +class basic_json; + +/// @brief JSON Pointer defines a string syntax for identifying a specific value within a JSON document +/// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/json_pointer/ +template +class json_pointer; + +/*! +@brief default specialization +@sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/json/ +*/ +using json = basic_json<>; + +/// @brief a minimal map-like container that preserves insertion order +/// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/ordered_map/ +template +struct ordered_map; + +/// @brief specialization that maintains the insertion order of object keys +/// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/ordered_json/ +using ordered_json = basic_json; + +} // namespace nlohmann + +#endif // INCLUDE_NLOHMANN_JSON_FWD_HPP_ + + +namespace nlohmann +{ +/*! +@brief detail namespace with internal helper functions + +This namespace collects functions that should not be exposed, +implementations of some @ref basic_json methods, and meta-programming helpers. + +@since version 2.1.0 +*/ +namespace detail +{ +///////////// +// helpers // +///////////// + +// Note to maintainers: +// +// Every trait in this file expects a non CV-qualified type. +// The only exceptions are in the 'aliases for detected' section +// (i.e. those of the form: decltype(T::member_function(std::declval()))) +// +// In this case, T has to be properly CV-qualified to constraint the function arguments +// (e.g. to_json(BasicJsonType&, const T&)) + +template struct is_basic_json : std::false_type {}; + +NLOHMANN_BASIC_JSON_TPL_DECLARATION +struct is_basic_json : std::true_type {}; + +////////////////////// +// json_ref helpers // +////////////////////// + +template +class json_ref; + +template +struct is_json_ref : std::false_type {}; + +template +struct is_json_ref> : std::true_type {}; + +////////////////////////// +// aliases for detected // +////////////////////////// + +template +using mapped_type_t = typename T::mapped_type; + +template +using key_type_t = typename T::key_type; + +template +using value_type_t = typename T::value_type; + +template +using difference_type_t = typename T::difference_type; + +template +using pointer_t = typename T::pointer; + +template +using reference_t = typename T::reference; + +template +using iterator_category_t = typename T::iterator_category; + +template +using to_json_function = decltype(T::to_json(std::declval()...)); + +template +using from_json_function = decltype(T::from_json(std::declval()...)); + +template +using get_template_function = decltype(std::declval().template get()); + +// trait checking if JSONSerializer::from_json(json const&, udt&) exists +template +struct has_from_json : std::false_type {}; + +// trait checking if j.get is valid +// use this trait instead of std::is_constructible or std::is_convertible, +// both rely on, or make use of implicit conversions, and thus fail when T +// has several constructors/operator= (see https://github.com/nlohmann/json/issues/958) +template +struct is_getable +{ + static constexpr bool value = is_detected::value; +}; + +template +struct has_from_json < BasicJsonType, T, enable_if_t < !is_basic_json::value >> +{ + using serializer = typename BasicJsonType::template json_serializer; + + static constexpr bool value = + is_detected_exact::value; +}; + +// This trait checks if JSONSerializer::from_json(json const&) exists +// this overload is used for non-default-constructible user-defined-types +template +struct has_non_default_from_json : std::false_type {}; + +template +struct has_non_default_from_json < BasicJsonType, T, enable_if_t < !is_basic_json::value >> +{ + using serializer = typename BasicJsonType::template json_serializer; + + static constexpr bool value = + is_detected_exact::value; +}; + +// This trait checks if BasicJsonType::json_serializer::to_json exists +// Do not evaluate the trait when T is a basic_json type, to avoid template instantiation infinite recursion. +template +struct has_to_json : std::false_type {}; + +template +struct has_to_json < BasicJsonType, T, enable_if_t < !is_basic_json::value >> +{ + using serializer = typename BasicJsonType::template json_serializer; + + static constexpr bool value = + is_detected_exact::value; +}; + + +/////////////////// +// is_ functions // +/////////////////// + +// https://en.cppreference.com/w/cpp/types/conjunction +template struct conjunction : std::true_type { }; +template struct conjunction : B1 { }; +template +struct conjunction +: std::conditional, B1>::type {}; + +// https://en.cppreference.com/w/cpp/types/negation +template struct negation : std::integral_constant < bool, !B::value > { }; + +// Reimplementation of is_constructible and is_default_constructible, due to them being broken for +// std::pair and std::tuple until LWG 2367 fix (see https://cplusplus.github.io/LWG/lwg-defects.html#2367). +// This causes compile errors in e.g. clang 3.5 or gcc 4.9. +template +struct is_default_constructible : std::is_default_constructible {}; + +template +struct is_default_constructible> + : conjunction, is_default_constructible> {}; + +template +struct is_default_constructible> + : conjunction, is_default_constructible> {}; + +template +struct is_default_constructible> + : conjunction...> {}; + +template +struct is_default_constructible> + : conjunction...> {}; + + +template +struct is_constructible : std::is_constructible {}; + +template +struct is_constructible> : is_default_constructible> {}; + +template +struct is_constructible> : is_default_constructible> {}; + +template +struct is_constructible> : is_default_constructible> {}; + +template +struct is_constructible> : is_default_constructible> {}; + + +template +struct is_iterator_traits : std::false_type {}; + +template +struct is_iterator_traits> +{ + private: + using traits = iterator_traits; + + public: + static constexpr auto value = + is_detected::value && + is_detected::value && + is_detected::value && + is_detected::value && + is_detected::value; +}; + +template +struct is_range +{ + private: + using t_ref = typename std::add_lvalue_reference::type; + + using iterator = detected_t; + using sentinel = detected_t; + + // to be 100% correct, it should use https://en.cppreference.com/w/cpp/iterator/input_or_output_iterator + // and https://en.cppreference.com/w/cpp/iterator/sentinel_for + // but reimplementing these would be too much work, as a lot of other concepts are used underneath + static constexpr auto is_iterator_begin = + is_iterator_traits>::value; + + public: + static constexpr bool value = !std::is_same::value && !std::is_same::value && is_iterator_begin; +}; + +template +using iterator_t = enable_if_t::value, result_of_begin())>>; + +template +using range_value_t = value_type_t>>; + +// The following implementation of is_complete_type is taken from +// https://blogs.msdn.microsoft.com/vcblog/2015/12/02/partial-support-for-expression-sfinae-in-vs-2015-update-1/ +// and is written by Xiang Fan who agreed to using it in this library. + +template +struct is_complete_type : std::false_type {}; + +template +struct is_complete_type : std::true_type {}; + +template +struct is_compatible_object_type_impl : std::false_type {}; + +template +struct is_compatible_object_type_impl < + BasicJsonType, CompatibleObjectType, + enable_if_t < is_detected::value&& + is_detected::value >> +{ + using object_t = typename BasicJsonType::object_t; + + // macOS's is_constructible does not play well with nonesuch... + static constexpr bool value = + is_constructible::value && + is_constructible::value; +}; + +template +struct is_compatible_object_type + : is_compatible_object_type_impl {}; + +template +struct is_constructible_object_type_impl : std::false_type {}; + +template +struct is_constructible_object_type_impl < + BasicJsonType, ConstructibleObjectType, + enable_if_t < is_detected::value&& + is_detected::value >> +{ + using object_t = typename BasicJsonType::object_t; + + static constexpr bool value = + (is_default_constructible::value && + (std::is_move_assignable::value || + std::is_copy_assignable::value) && + (is_constructible::value && + std::is_same < + typename object_t::mapped_type, + typename ConstructibleObjectType::mapped_type >::value)) || + (has_from_json::value || + has_non_default_from_json < + BasicJsonType, + typename ConstructibleObjectType::mapped_type >::value); +}; + +template +struct is_constructible_object_type + : is_constructible_object_type_impl {}; + +template +struct is_compatible_string_type +{ + static constexpr auto value = + is_constructible::value; +}; + +template +struct is_constructible_string_type +{ + static constexpr auto value = + is_constructible::value; +}; + +template +struct is_compatible_array_type_impl : std::false_type {}; + +template +struct is_compatible_array_type_impl < + BasicJsonType, CompatibleArrayType, + enable_if_t < + is_detected::value&& + is_iterator_traits>>::value&& +// special case for types like std::filesystem::path whose iterator's value_type are themselves +// c.f. https://github.com/nlohmann/json/pull/3073 + !std::is_same>::value >> +{ + static constexpr bool value = + is_constructible>::value; +}; + +template +struct is_compatible_array_type + : is_compatible_array_type_impl {}; + +template +struct is_constructible_array_type_impl : std::false_type {}; + +template +struct is_constructible_array_type_impl < + BasicJsonType, ConstructibleArrayType, + enable_if_t::value >> + : std::true_type {}; + +template +struct is_constructible_array_type_impl < + BasicJsonType, ConstructibleArrayType, + enable_if_t < !std::is_same::value&& + !is_compatible_string_type::value&& + is_default_constructible::value&& +(std::is_move_assignable::value || + std::is_copy_assignable::value)&& +is_detected::value&& +is_iterator_traits>>::value&& +is_detected::value&& +// special case for types like std::filesystem::path whose iterator's value_type are themselves +// c.f. https://github.com/nlohmann/json/pull/3073 +!std::is_same>::value&& + is_complete_type < + detected_t>::value >> +{ + using value_type = range_value_t; + + static constexpr bool value = + std::is_same::value || + has_from_json::value || + has_non_default_from_json < + BasicJsonType, + value_type >::value; +}; + +template +struct is_constructible_array_type + : is_constructible_array_type_impl {}; + +template +struct is_compatible_integer_type_impl : std::false_type {}; + +template +struct is_compatible_integer_type_impl < + RealIntegerType, CompatibleNumberIntegerType, + enable_if_t < std::is_integral::value&& + std::is_integral::value&& + !std::is_same::value >> +{ + // is there an assert somewhere on overflows? + using RealLimits = std::numeric_limits; + using CompatibleLimits = std::numeric_limits; + + static constexpr auto value = + is_constructible::value && + CompatibleLimits::is_integer && + RealLimits::is_signed == CompatibleLimits::is_signed; +}; + +template +struct is_compatible_integer_type + : is_compatible_integer_type_impl {}; + +template +struct is_compatible_type_impl: std::false_type {}; + +template +struct is_compatible_type_impl < + BasicJsonType, CompatibleType, + enable_if_t::value >> +{ + static constexpr bool value = + has_to_json::value; +}; + +template +struct is_compatible_type + : is_compatible_type_impl {}; + +template +struct is_constructible_tuple : std::false_type {}; + +template +struct is_constructible_tuple> : conjunction...> {}; + +// a naive helper to check if a type is an ordered_map (exploits the fact that +// ordered_map inherits capacity() from std::vector) +template +struct is_ordered_map +{ + using one = char; + + struct two + { + char x[2]; // NOLINT(cppcoreguidelines-avoid-c-arrays,hicpp-avoid-c-arrays,modernize-avoid-c-arrays) + }; + + template static one test( decltype(&C::capacity) ) ; + template static two test(...); + + enum { value = sizeof(test(nullptr)) == sizeof(char) }; // NOLINT(cppcoreguidelines-pro-type-vararg,hicpp-vararg) +}; + +// to avoid useless casts (see https://github.com/nlohmann/json/issues/2893#issuecomment-889152324) +template < typename T, typename U, enable_if_t < !std::is_same::value, int > = 0 > +T conditional_static_cast(U value) +{ + return static_cast(value); +} + +template::value, int> = 0> +T conditional_static_cast(U value) +{ + return value; +} + +} // namespace detail +} // namespace nlohmann + +// #include + + +#if JSON_HAS_EXPERIMENTAL_FILESYSTEM +#include +namespace nlohmann::detail +{ +namespace std_fs = std::experimental::filesystem; +} // namespace nlohmann::detail +#elif JSON_HAS_FILESYSTEM +#include +namespace nlohmann::detail +{ +namespace std_fs = std::filesystem; +} // namespace nlohmann::detail +#endif + +namespace nlohmann +{ +namespace detail +{ +template +void from_json(const BasicJsonType& j, typename std::nullptr_t& n) +{ + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!j.is_null())) + { + JSON_THROW(type_error::create(302, "type must be null, but is " + std::string(j.type_name()), j)); + } + n = nullptr; +} + +// overloads for basic_json template parameters +template < typename BasicJsonType, typename ArithmeticType, + enable_if_t < std::is_arithmetic::value&& + !std::is_same::value, + int > = 0 > +void get_arithmetic_value(const BasicJsonType& j, ArithmeticType& val) +{ + switch (static_cast(j)) + { + case value_t::number_unsigned: + { + val = static_cast(*j.template get_ptr()); + break; + } + case value_t::number_integer: + { + val = static_cast(*j.template get_ptr()); + break; + } + case value_t::number_float: + { + val = static_cast(*j.template get_ptr()); + break; + } + + case value_t::null: + case value_t::object: + case value_t::array: + case value_t::string: + case value_t::boolean: + case value_t::binary: + case value_t::discarded: + default: + JSON_THROW(type_error::create(302, "type must be number, but is " + std::string(j.type_name()), j)); + } +} + +template +void from_json(const BasicJsonType& j, typename BasicJsonType::boolean_t& b) +{ + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!j.is_boolean())) + { + JSON_THROW(type_error::create(302, "type must be boolean, but is " + std::string(j.type_name()), j)); + } + b = *j.template get_ptr(); +} + +template +void from_json(const BasicJsonType& j, typename BasicJsonType::string_t& s) +{ + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!j.is_string())) + { + JSON_THROW(type_error::create(302, "type must be string, but is " + std::string(j.type_name()), j)); + } + s = *j.template get_ptr(); +} + +template < + typename BasicJsonType, typename ConstructibleStringType, + enable_if_t < + is_constructible_string_type::value&& + !std::is_same::value, + int > = 0 > +void from_json(const BasicJsonType& j, ConstructibleStringType& s) +{ + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!j.is_string())) + { + JSON_THROW(type_error::create(302, "type must be string, but is " + std::string(j.type_name()), j)); + } + + s = *j.template get_ptr(); +} + +template +void from_json(const BasicJsonType& j, typename BasicJsonType::number_float_t& val) +{ + get_arithmetic_value(j, val); +} + +template +void from_json(const BasicJsonType& j, typename BasicJsonType::number_unsigned_t& val) +{ + get_arithmetic_value(j, val); +} + +template +void from_json(const BasicJsonType& j, typename BasicJsonType::number_integer_t& val) +{ + get_arithmetic_value(j, val); +} + +template::value, int> = 0> +void from_json(const BasicJsonType& j, EnumType& e) +{ + typename std::underlying_type::type val; + get_arithmetic_value(j, val); + e = static_cast(val); +} + +// forward_list doesn't have an insert method +template::value, int> = 0> +void from_json(const BasicJsonType& j, std::forward_list& l) +{ + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!j.is_array())) + { + JSON_THROW(type_error::create(302, "type must be array, but is " + std::string(j.type_name()), j)); + } + l.clear(); + std::transform(j.rbegin(), j.rend(), + std::front_inserter(l), [](const BasicJsonType & i) + { + return i.template get(); + }); +} + +// valarray doesn't have an insert method +template::value, int> = 0> +void from_json(const BasicJsonType& j, std::valarray& l) +{ + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!j.is_array())) + { + JSON_THROW(type_error::create(302, "type must be array, but is " + std::string(j.type_name()), j)); + } + l.resize(j.size()); + std::transform(j.begin(), j.end(), std::begin(l), + [](const BasicJsonType & elem) + { + return elem.template get(); + }); +} + +template +auto from_json(const BasicJsonType& j, T (&arr)[N]) // NOLINT(cppcoreguidelines-avoid-c-arrays,hicpp-avoid-c-arrays,modernize-avoid-c-arrays) +-> decltype(j.template get(), void()) +{ + for (std::size_t i = 0; i < N; ++i) + { + arr[i] = j.at(i).template get(); + } +} + +template +void from_json_array_impl(const BasicJsonType& j, typename BasicJsonType::array_t& arr, priority_tag<3> /*unused*/) +{ + arr = *j.template get_ptr(); +} + +template +auto from_json_array_impl(const BasicJsonType& j, std::array& arr, + priority_tag<2> /*unused*/) +-> decltype(j.template get(), void()) +{ + for (std::size_t i = 0; i < N; ++i) + { + arr[i] = j.at(i).template get(); + } +} + +template::value, + int> = 0> +auto from_json_array_impl(const BasicJsonType& j, ConstructibleArrayType& arr, priority_tag<1> /*unused*/) +-> decltype( + arr.reserve(std::declval()), + j.template get(), + void()) +{ + using std::end; + + ConstructibleArrayType ret; + ret.reserve(j.size()); + std::transform(j.begin(), j.end(), + std::inserter(ret, end(ret)), [](const BasicJsonType & i) + { + // get() returns *this, this won't call a from_json + // method when value_type is BasicJsonType + return i.template get(); + }); + arr = std::move(ret); +} + +template::value, + int> = 0> +void from_json_array_impl(const BasicJsonType& j, ConstructibleArrayType& arr, + priority_tag<0> /*unused*/) +{ + using std::end; + + ConstructibleArrayType ret; + std::transform( + j.begin(), j.end(), std::inserter(ret, end(ret)), + [](const BasicJsonType & i) + { + // get() returns *this, this won't call a from_json + // method when value_type is BasicJsonType + return i.template get(); + }); + arr = std::move(ret); +} + +template < typename BasicJsonType, typename ConstructibleArrayType, + enable_if_t < + is_constructible_array_type::value&& + !is_constructible_object_type::value&& + !is_constructible_string_type::value&& + !std::is_same::value&& + !is_basic_json::value, + int > = 0 > +auto from_json(const BasicJsonType& j, ConstructibleArrayType& arr) +-> decltype(from_json_array_impl(j, arr, priority_tag<3> {}), +j.template get(), +void()) +{ + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!j.is_array())) + { + JSON_THROW(type_error::create(302, "type must be array, but is " + std::string(j.type_name()), j)); + } + + from_json_array_impl(j, arr, priority_tag<3> {}); +} + +template < typename BasicJsonType, typename T, std::size_t... Idx > +std::array from_json_inplace_array_impl(BasicJsonType&& j, + identity_tag> /*unused*/, index_sequence /*unused*/) +{ + return { { std::forward(j).at(Idx).template get()... } }; +} + +template < typename BasicJsonType, typename T, std::size_t N > +auto from_json(BasicJsonType&& j, identity_tag> tag) +-> decltype(from_json_inplace_array_impl(std::forward(j), tag, make_index_sequence {})) +{ + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!j.is_array())) + { + JSON_THROW(type_error::create(302, "type must be array, but is " + std::string(j.type_name()), j)); + } + + return from_json_inplace_array_impl(std::forward(j), tag, make_index_sequence {}); +} + +template +void from_json(const BasicJsonType& j, typename BasicJsonType::binary_t& bin) +{ + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!j.is_binary())) + { + JSON_THROW(type_error::create(302, "type must be binary, but is " + std::string(j.type_name()), j)); + } + + bin = *j.template get_ptr(); +} + +template::value, int> = 0> +void from_json(const BasicJsonType& j, ConstructibleObjectType& obj) +{ + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!j.is_object())) + { + JSON_THROW(type_error::create(302, "type must be object, but is " + std::string(j.type_name()), j)); + } + + ConstructibleObjectType ret; + const auto* inner_object = j.template get_ptr(); + using value_type = typename ConstructibleObjectType::value_type; + std::transform( + inner_object->begin(), inner_object->end(), + std::inserter(ret, ret.begin()), + [](typename BasicJsonType::object_t::value_type const & p) + { + return value_type(p.first, p.second.template get()); + }); + obj = std::move(ret); +} + +// overload for arithmetic types, not chosen for basic_json template arguments +// (BooleanType, etc..); note: Is it really necessary to provide explicit +// overloads for boolean_t etc. in case of a custom BooleanType which is not +// an arithmetic type? +template < typename BasicJsonType, typename ArithmeticType, + enable_if_t < + std::is_arithmetic::value&& + !std::is_same::value&& + !std::is_same::value&& + !std::is_same::value&& + !std::is_same::value, + int > = 0 > +void from_json(const BasicJsonType& j, ArithmeticType& val) +{ + switch (static_cast(j)) + { + case value_t::number_unsigned: + { + val = static_cast(*j.template get_ptr()); + break; + } + case value_t::number_integer: + { + val = static_cast(*j.template get_ptr()); + break; + } + case value_t::number_float: + { + val = static_cast(*j.template get_ptr()); + break; + } + case value_t::boolean: + { + val = static_cast(*j.template get_ptr()); + break; + } + + case value_t::null: + case value_t::object: + case value_t::array: + case value_t::string: + case value_t::binary: + case value_t::discarded: + default: + JSON_THROW(type_error::create(302, "type must be number, but is " + std::string(j.type_name()), j)); + } +} + +template +std::tuple from_json_tuple_impl_base(BasicJsonType&& j, index_sequence /*unused*/) +{ + return std::make_tuple(std::forward(j).at(Idx).template get()...); +} + +template < typename BasicJsonType, class A1, class A2 > +std::pair from_json_tuple_impl(BasicJsonType&& j, identity_tag> /*unused*/, priority_tag<0> /*unused*/) +{ + return {std::forward(j).at(0).template get(), + std::forward(j).at(1).template get()}; +} + +template +void from_json_tuple_impl(BasicJsonType&& j, std::pair& p, priority_tag<1> /*unused*/) +{ + p = from_json_tuple_impl(std::forward(j), identity_tag> {}, priority_tag<0> {}); +} + +template +std::tuple from_json_tuple_impl(BasicJsonType&& j, identity_tag> /*unused*/, priority_tag<2> /*unused*/) +{ + return from_json_tuple_impl_base(std::forward(j), index_sequence_for {}); +} + +template +void from_json_tuple_impl(BasicJsonType&& j, std::tuple& t, priority_tag<3> /*unused*/) +{ + t = from_json_tuple_impl_base(std::forward(j), index_sequence_for {}); +} + +template +auto from_json(BasicJsonType&& j, TupleRelated&& t) +-> decltype(from_json_tuple_impl(std::forward(j), std::forward(t), priority_tag<3> {})) +{ + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!j.is_array())) + { + JSON_THROW(type_error::create(302, "type must be array, but is " + std::string(j.type_name()), j)); + } + + return from_json_tuple_impl(std::forward(j), std::forward(t), priority_tag<3> {}); +} + +template < typename BasicJsonType, typename Key, typename Value, typename Compare, typename Allocator, + typename = enable_if_t < !std::is_constructible < + typename BasicJsonType::string_t, Key >::value >> +void from_json(const BasicJsonType& j, std::map& m) +{ + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!j.is_array())) + { + JSON_THROW(type_error::create(302, "type must be array, but is " + std::string(j.type_name()), j)); + } + m.clear(); + for (const auto& p : j) + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!p.is_array())) + { + JSON_THROW(type_error::create(302, "type must be array, but is " + std::string(p.type_name()), j)); + } + m.emplace(p.at(0).template get(), p.at(1).template get()); + } +} + +template < typename BasicJsonType, typename Key, typename Value, typename Hash, typename KeyEqual, typename Allocator, + typename = enable_if_t < !std::is_constructible < + typename BasicJsonType::string_t, Key >::value >> +void from_json(const BasicJsonType& j, std::unordered_map& m) +{ + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!j.is_array())) + { + JSON_THROW(type_error::create(302, "type must be array, but is " + std::string(j.type_name()), j)); + } + m.clear(); + for (const auto& p : j) + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!p.is_array())) + { + JSON_THROW(type_error::create(302, "type must be array, but is " + std::string(p.type_name()), j)); + } + m.emplace(p.at(0).template get(), p.at(1).template get()); + } +} + +#if JSON_HAS_FILESYSTEM || JSON_HAS_EXPERIMENTAL_FILESYSTEM +template +void from_json(const BasicJsonType& j, std_fs::path& p) +{ + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!j.is_string())) + { + JSON_THROW(type_error::create(302, "type must be string, but is " + std::string(j.type_name()), j)); + } + p = *j.template get_ptr(); +} +#endif + +struct from_json_fn +{ + template + auto operator()(const BasicJsonType& j, T&& val) const + noexcept(noexcept(from_json(j, std::forward(val)))) + -> decltype(from_json(j, std::forward(val))) + { + return from_json(j, std::forward(val)); + } +}; +} // namespace detail + +/// namespace to hold default `from_json` function +/// to see why this is required: +/// http://www.open-std.org/jtc1/sc22/wg21/docs/papers/2015/n4381.html +namespace // NOLINT(cert-dcl59-cpp,fuchsia-header-anon-namespaces,google-build-namespaces) +{ +constexpr const auto& from_json = detail::static_const::value; // NOLINT(misc-definitions-in-headers) +} // namespace +} // namespace nlohmann + +// #include + + +#include // copy +#include // begin, end +#include // string +#include // tuple, get +#include // is_same, is_constructible, is_floating_point, is_enum, underlying_type +#include // move, forward, declval, pair +#include // valarray +#include // vector + +// #include + +// #include + + +#include // size_t +#include // input_iterator_tag +#include // string, to_string +#include // tuple_size, get, tuple_element +#include // move + +// #include + +// #include + + +namespace nlohmann +{ +namespace detail +{ +template +void int_to_string( string_type& target, std::size_t value ) +{ + // For ADL + using std::to_string; + target = to_string(value); +} +template class iteration_proxy_value +{ + public: + using difference_type = std::ptrdiff_t; + using value_type = iteration_proxy_value; + using pointer = value_type * ; + using reference = value_type & ; + using iterator_category = std::input_iterator_tag; + using string_type = typename std::remove_cv< typename std::remove_reference().key() ) >::type >::type; + + private: + /// the iterator + IteratorType anchor; + /// an index for arrays (used to create key names) + std::size_t array_index = 0; + /// last stringified array index + mutable std::size_t array_index_last = 0; + /// a string representation of the array index + mutable string_type array_index_str = "0"; + /// an empty string (to return a reference for primitive values) + const string_type empty_str{}; + + public: + explicit iteration_proxy_value(IteratorType it) noexcept + : anchor(std::move(it)) + {} + + /// dereference operator (needed for range-based for) + iteration_proxy_value& operator*() + { + return *this; + } + + /// increment operator (needed for range-based for) + iteration_proxy_value& operator++() + { + ++anchor; + ++array_index; + + return *this; + } + + /// equality operator (needed for InputIterator) + bool operator==(const iteration_proxy_value& o) const + { + return anchor == o.anchor; + } + + /// inequality operator (needed for range-based for) + bool operator!=(const iteration_proxy_value& o) const + { + return anchor != o.anchor; + } + + /// return key of the iterator + const string_type& key() const + { + JSON_ASSERT(anchor.m_object != nullptr); + + switch (anchor.m_object->type()) + { + // use integer array index as key + case value_t::array: + { + if (array_index != array_index_last) + { + int_to_string( array_index_str, array_index ); + array_index_last = array_index; + } + return array_index_str; + } + + // use key from the object + case value_t::object: + return anchor.key(); + + // use an empty key for all primitive types + case value_t::null: + case value_t::string: + case value_t::boolean: + case value_t::number_integer: + case value_t::number_unsigned: + case value_t::number_float: + case value_t::binary: + case value_t::discarded: + default: + return empty_str; + } + } + + /// return value of the iterator + typename IteratorType::reference value() const + { + return anchor.value(); + } +}; + +/// proxy class for the items() function +template class iteration_proxy +{ + private: + /// the container to iterate + typename IteratorType::reference container; + + public: + /// construct iteration proxy from a container + explicit iteration_proxy(typename IteratorType::reference cont) noexcept + : container(cont) {} + + /// return iterator begin (needed for range-based for) + iteration_proxy_value begin() noexcept + { + return iteration_proxy_value(container.begin()); + } + + /// return iterator end (needed for range-based for) + iteration_proxy_value end() noexcept + { + return iteration_proxy_value(container.end()); + } +}; +// Structured Bindings Support +// For further reference see https://blog.tartanllama.xyz/structured-bindings/ +// And see https://github.com/nlohmann/json/pull/1391 +template = 0> +auto get(const nlohmann::detail::iteration_proxy_value& i) -> decltype(i.key()) +{ + return i.key(); +} +// Structured Bindings Support +// For further reference see https://blog.tartanllama.xyz/structured-bindings/ +// And see https://github.com/nlohmann/json/pull/1391 +template = 0> +auto get(const nlohmann::detail::iteration_proxy_value& i) -> decltype(i.value()) +{ + return i.value(); +} +} // namespace detail +} // namespace nlohmann + +// The Addition to the STD Namespace is required to add +// Structured Bindings Support to the iteration_proxy_value class +// For further reference see https://blog.tartanllama.xyz/structured-bindings/ +// And see https://github.com/nlohmann/json/pull/1391 +namespace std +{ +#if defined(__clang__) + // Fix: https://github.com/nlohmann/json/issues/1401 + #pragma clang diagnostic push + #pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wmismatched-tags" +#endif +template +class tuple_size<::nlohmann::detail::iteration_proxy_value> + : public std::integral_constant {}; + +template +class tuple_element> +{ + public: + using type = decltype( + get(std::declval < + ::nlohmann::detail::iteration_proxy_value> ())); +}; +#if defined(__clang__) + #pragma clang diagnostic pop +#endif +} // namespace std + +// #include + +// #include + +// #include + + +#if JSON_HAS_EXPERIMENTAL_FILESYSTEM +#include +namespace nlohmann::detail +{ +namespace std_fs = std::experimental::filesystem; +} // namespace nlohmann::detail +#elif JSON_HAS_FILESYSTEM +#include +namespace nlohmann::detail +{ +namespace std_fs = std::filesystem; +} // namespace nlohmann::detail +#endif + +namespace nlohmann +{ +namespace detail +{ +////////////////// +// constructors // +////////////////// + +/* + * Note all external_constructor<>::construct functions need to call + * j.m_value.destroy(j.m_type) to avoid a memory leak in case j contains an + * allocated value (e.g., a string). See bug issue + * https://github.com/nlohmann/json/issues/2865 for more information. + */ + +template struct external_constructor; + +template<> +struct external_constructor +{ + template + static void construct(BasicJsonType& j, typename BasicJsonType::boolean_t b) noexcept + { + j.m_value.destroy(j.m_type); + j.m_type = value_t::boolean; + j.m_value = b; + j.assert_invariant(); + } +}; + +template<> +struct external_constructor +{ + template + static void construct(BasicJsonType& j, const typename BasicJsonType::string_t& s) + { + j.m_value.destroy(j.m_type); + j.m_type = value_t::string; + j.m_value = s; + j.assert_invariant(); + } + + template + static void construct(BasicJsonType& j, typename BasicJsonType::string_t&& s) + { + j.m_value.destroy(j.m_type); + j.m_type = value_t::string; + j.m_value = std::move(s); + j.assert_invariant(); + } + + template < typename BasicJsonType, typename CompatibleStringType, + enable_if_t < !std::is_same::value, + int > = 0 > + static void construct(BasicJsonType& j, const CompatibleStringType& str) + { + j.m_value.destroy(j.m_type); + j.m_type = value_t::string; + j.m_value.string = j.template create(str); + j.assert_invariant(); + } +}; + +template<> +struct external_constructor +{ + template + static void construct(BasicJsonType& j, const typename BasicJsonType::binary_t& b) + { + j.m_value.destroy(j.m_type); + j.m_type = value_t::binary; + j.m_value = typename BasicJsonType::binary_t(b); + j.assert_invariant(); + } + + template + static void construct(BasicJsonType& j, typename BasicJsonType::binary_t&& b) + { + j.m_value.destroy(j.m_type); + j.m_type = value_t::binary; + j.m_value = typename BasicJsonType::binary_t(std::move(b)); + j.assert_invariant(); + } +}; + +template<> +struct external_constructor +{ + template + static void construct(BasicJsonType& j, typename BasicJsonType::number_float_t val) noexcept + { + j.m_value.destroy(j.m_type); + j.m_type = value_t::number_float; + j.m_value = val; + j.assert_invariant(); + } +}; + +template<> +struct external_constructor +{ + template + static void construct(BasicJsonType& j, typename BasicJsonType::number_unsigned_t val) noexcept + { + j.m_value.destroy(j.m_type); + j.m_type = value_t::number_unsigned; + j.m_value = val; + j.assert_invariant(); + } +}; + +template<> +struct external_constructor +{ + template + static void construct(BasicJsonType& j, typename BasicJsonType::number_integer_t val) noexcept + { + j.m_value.destroy(j.m_type); + j.m_type = value_t::number_integer; + j.m_value = val; + j.assert_invariant(); + } +}; + +template<> +struct external_constructor +{ + template + static void construct(BasicJsonType& j, const typename BasicJsonType::array_t& arr) + { + j.m_value.destroy(j.m_type); + j.m_type = value_t::array; + j.m_value = arr; + j.set_parents(); + j.assert_invariant(); + } + + template + static void construct(BasicJsonType& j, typename BasicJsonType::array_t&& arr) + { + j.m_value.destroy(j.m_type); + j.m_type = value_t::array; + j.m_value = std::move(arr); + j.set_parents(); + j.assert_invariant(); + } + + template < typename BasicJsonType, typename CompatibleArrayType, + enable_if_t < !std::is_same::value, + int > = 0 > + static void construct(BasicJsonType& j, const CompatibleArrayType& arr) + { + using std::begin; + using std::end; + + j.m_value.destroy(j.m_type); + j.m_type = value_t::array; + j.m_value.array = j.template create(begin(arr), end(arr)); + j.set_parents(); + j.assert_invariant(); + } + + template + static void construct(BasicJsonType& j, const std::vector& arr) + { + j.m_value.destroy(j.m_type); + j.m_type = value_t::array; + j.m_value = value_t::array; + j.m_value.array->reserve(arr.size()); + for (const bool x : arr) + { + j.m_value.array->push_back(x); + j.set_parent(j.m_value.array->back()); + } + j.assert_invariant(); + } + + template::value, int> = 0> + static void construct(BasicJsonType& j, const std::valarray& arr) + { + j.m_value.destroy(j.m_type); + j.m_type = value_t::array; + j.m_value = value_t::array; + j.m_value.array->resize(arr.size()); + if (arr.size() > 0) + { + std::copy(std::begin(arr), std::end(arr), j.m_value.array->begin()); + } + j.set_parents(); + j.assert_invariant(); + } +}; + +template<> +struct external_constructor +{ + template + static void construct(BasicJsonType& j, const typename BasicJsonType::object_t& obj) + { + j.m_value.destroy(j.m_type); + j.m_type = value_t::object; + j.m_value = obj; + j.set_parents(); + j.assert_invariant(); + } + + template + static void construct(BasicJsonType& j, typename BasicJsonType::object_t&& obj) + { + j.m_value.destroy(j.m_type); + j.m_type = value_t::object; + j.m_value = std::move(obj); + j.set_parents(); + j.assert_invariant(); + } + + template < typename BasicJsonType, typename CompatibleObjectType, + enable_if_t < !std::is_same::value, int > = 0 > + static void construct(BasicJsonType& j, const CompatibleObjectType& obj) + { + using std::begin; + using std::end; + + j.m_value.destroy(j.m_type); + j.m_type = value_t::object; + j.m_value.object = j.template create(begin(obj), end(obj)); + j.set_parents(); + j.assert_invariant(); + } +}; + +///////////// +// to_json // +///////////// + +template::value, int> = 0> +void to_json(BasicJsonType& j, T b) noexcept +{ + external_constructor::construct(j, b); +} + +template::value, int> = 0> +void to_json(BasicJsonType& j, const CompatibleString& s) +{ + external_constructor::construct(j, s); +} + +template +void to_json(BasicJsonType& j, typename BasicJsonType::string_t&& s) +{ + external_constructor::construct(j, std::move(s)); +} + +template::value, int> = 0> +void to_json(BasicJsonType& j, FloatType val) noexcept +{ + external_constructor::construct(j, static_cast(val)); +} + +template::value, int> = 0> +void to_json(BasicJsonType& j, CompatibleNumberUnsignedType val) noexcept +{ + external_constructor::construct(j, static_cast(val)); +} + +template::value, int> = 0> +void to_json(BasicJsonType& j, CompatibleNumberIntegerType val) noexcept +{ + external_constructor::construct(j, static_cast(val)); +} + +template::value, int> = 0> +void to_json(BasicJsonType& j, EnumType e) noexcept +{ + using underlying_type = typename std::underlying_type::type; + external_constructor::construct(j, static_cast(e)); +} + +template +void to_json(BasicJsonType& j, const std::vector& e) +{ + external_constructor::construct(j, e); +} + +template < typename BasicJsonType, typename CompatibleArrayType, + enable_if_t < is_compatible_array_type::value&& + !is_compatible_object_type::value&& + !is_compatible_string_type::value&& + !std::is_same::value&& + !is_basic_json::value, + int > = 0 > +void to_json(BasicJsonType& j, const CompatibleArrayType& arr) +{ + external_constructor::construct(j, arr); +} + +template +void to_json(BasicJsonType& j, const typename BasicJsonType::binary_t& bin) +{ + external_constructor::construct(j, bin); +} + +template::value, int> = 0> +void to_json(BasicJsonType& j, const std::valarray& arr) +{ + external_constructor::construct(j, std::move(arr)); +} + +template +void to_json(BasicJsonType& j, typename BasicJsonType::array_t&& arr) +{ + external_constructor::construct(j, std::move(arr)); +} + +template < typename BasicJsonType, typename CompatibleObjectType, + enable_if_t < is_compatible_object_type::value&& !is_basic_json::value, int > = 0 > +void to_json(BasicJsonType& j, const CompatibleObjectType& obj) +{ + external_constructor::construct(j, obj); +} + +template +void to_json(BasicJsonType& j, typename BasicJsonType::object_t&& obj) +{ + external_constructor::construct(j, std::move(obj)); +} + +template < + typename BasicJsonType, typename T, std::size_t N, + enable_if_t < !std::is_constructible::value, // NOLINT(cppcoreguidelines-avoid-c-arrays,hicpp-avoid-c-arrays,modernize-avoid-c-arrays) + int > = 0 > +void to_json(BasicJsonType& j, const T(&arr)[N]) // NOLINT(cppcoreguidelines-avoid-c-arrays,hicpp-avoid-c-arrays,modernize-avoid-c-arrays) +{ + external_constructor::construct(j, arr); +} + +template < typename BasicJsonType, typename T1, typename T2, enable_if_t < std::is_constructible::value&& std::is_constructible::value, int > = 0 > +void to_json(BasicJsonType& j, const std::pair& p) +{ + j = { p.first, p.second }; +} + +// for https://github.com/nlohmann/json/pull/1134 +template>::value, int> = 0> +void to_json(BasicJsonType& j, const T& b) +{ + j = { {b.key(), b.value()} }; +} + +template +void to_json_tuple_impl(BasicJsonType& j, const Tuple& t, index_sequence /*unused*/) +{ + j = { std::get(t)... }; +} + +template::value, int > = 0> +void to_json(BasicJsonType& j, const T& t) +{ + to_json_tuple_impl(j, t, make_index_sequence::value> {}); +} + +#if JSON_HAS_FILESYSTEM || JSON_HAS_EXPERIMENTAL_FILESYSTEM +template +void to_json(BasicJsonType& j, const std_fs::path& p) +{ + j = p.string(); +} +#endif + +struct to_json_fn +{ + template + auto operator()(BasicJsonType& j, T&& val) const noexcept(noexcept(to_json(j, std::forward(val)))) + -> decltype(to_json(j, std::forward(val)), void()) + { + return to_json(j, std::forward(val)); + } +}; +} // namespace detail + +/// namespace to hold default `to_json` function +/// to see why this is required: +/// http://www.open-std.org/jtc1/sc22/wg21/docs/papers/2015/n4381.html +namespace // NOLINT(cert-dcl59-cpp,fuchsia-header-anon-namespaces,google-build-namespaces) +{ +constexpr const auto& to_json = detail::static_const::value; // NOLINT(misc-definitions-in-headers) +} // namespace +} // namespace nlohmann + +// #include + +// #include + + +namespace nlohmann +{ + +/// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/adl_serializer/ +template +struct adl_serializer +{ + /// @brief convert a JSON value to any value type + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/adl_serializer/from_json/ + template + static auto from_json(BasicJsonType && j, TargetType& val) noexcept( + noexcept(::nlohmann::from_json(std::forward(j), val))) + -> decltype(::nlohmann::from_json(std::forward(j), val), void()) + { + ::nlohmann::from_json(std::forward(j), val); + } + + /// @brief convert a JSON value to any value type + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/adl_serializer/from_json/ + template + static auto from_json(BasicJsonType && j) noexcept( + noexcept(::nlohmann::from_json(std::forward(j), detail::identity_tag {}))) + -> decltype(::nlohmann::from_json(std::forward(j), detail::identity_tag {})) + { + return ::nlohmann::from_json(std::forward(j), detail::identity_tag {}); + } + + /// @brief convert any value type to a JSON value + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/adl_serializer/to_json/ + template + static auto to_json(BasicJsonType& j, TargetType && val) noexcept( + noexcept(::nlohmann::to_json(j, std::forward(val)))) + -> decltype(::nlohmann::to_json(j, std::forward(val)), void()) + { + ::nlohmann::to_json(j, std::forward(val)); + } +}; +} // namespace nlohmann + +// #include + + +#include // uint8_t, uint64_t +#include // tie +#include // move + +namespace nlohmann +{ + +/// @brief an internal type for a backed binary type +/// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/byte_container_with_subtype/ +template +class byte_container_with_subtype : public BinaryType +{ + public: + using container_type = BinaryType; + using subtype_type = std::uint64_t; + + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/byte_container_with_subtype/byte_container_with_subtype/ + byte_container_with_subtype() noexcept(noexcept(container_type())) + : container_type() + {} + + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/byte_container_with_subtype/byte_container_with_subtype/ + byte_container_with_subtype(const container_type& b) noexcept(noexcept(container_type(b))) + : container_type(b) + {} + + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/byte_container_with_subtype/byte_container_with_subtype/ + byte_container_with_subtype(container_type&& b) noexcept(noexcept(container_type(std::move(b)))) + : container_type(std::move(b)) + {} + + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/byte_container_with_subtype/byte_container_with_subtype/ + byte_container_with_subtype(const container_type& b, subtype_type subtype_) noexcept(noexcept(container_type(b))) + : container_type(b) + , m_subtype(subtype_) + , m_has_subtype(true) + {} + + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/byte_container_with_subtype/byte_container_with_subtype/ + byte_container_with_subtype(container_type&& b, subtype_type subtype_) noexcept(noexcept(container_type(std::move(b)))) + : container_type(std::move(b)) + , m_subtype(subtype_) + , m_has_subtype(true) + {} + + bool operator==(const byte_container_with_subtype& rhs) const + { + return std::tie(static_cast(*this), m_subtype, m_has_subtype) == + std::tie(static_cast(rhs), rhs.m_subtype, rhs.m_has_subtype); + } + + bool operator!=(const byte_container_with_subtype& rhs) const + { + return !(rhs == *this); + } + + /// @brief sets the binary subtype + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/byte_container_with_subtype/set_subtype/ + void set_subtype(subtype_type subtype_) noexcept + { + m_subtype = subtype_; + m_has_subtype = true; + } + + /// @brief return the binary subtype + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/byte_container_with_subtype/subtype/ + constexpr subtype_type subtype() const noexcept + { + return m_has_subtype ? m_subtype : static_cast(-1); + } + + /// @brief return whether the value has a subtype + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/byte_container_with_subtype/has_subtype/ + constexpr bool has_subtype() const noexcept + { + return m_has_subtype; + } + + /// @brief clears the binary subtype + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/byte_container_with_subtype/clear_subtype/ + void clear_subtype() noexcept + { + m_subtype = 0; + m_has_subtype = false; + } + + private: + subtype_type m_subtype = 0; + bool m_has_subtype = false; +}; + +} // namespace nlohmann + +// #include + +// #include + +// #include + +// #include + + +#include // uint8_t +#include // size_t +#include // hash + +// #include + +// #include + + +namespace nlohmann +{ +namespace detail +{ + +// boost::hash_combine +inline std::size_t combine(std::size_t seed, std::size_t h) noexcept +{ + seed ^= h + 0x9e3779b9 + (seed << 6U) + (seed >> 2U); + return seed; +} + +/*! +@brief hash a JSON value + +The hash function tries to rely on std::hash where possible. Furthermore, the +type of the JSON value is taken into account to have different hash values for +null, 0, 0U, and false, etc. + +@tparam BasicJsonType basic_json specialization +@param j JSON value to hash +@return hash value of j +*/ +template +std::size_t hash(const BasicJsonType& j) +{ + using string_t = typename BasicJsonType::string_t; + using number_integer_t = typename BasicJsonType::number_integer_t; + using number_unsigned_t = typename BasicJsonType::number_unsigned_t; + using number_float_t = typename BasicJsonType::number_float_t; + + const auto type = static_cast(j.type()); + switch (j.type()) + { + case BasicJsonType::value_t::null: + case BasicJsonType::value_t::discarded: + { + return combine(type, 0); + } + + case BasicJsonType::value_t::object: + { + auto seed = combine(type, j.size()); + for (const auto& element : j.items()) + { + const auto h = std::hash {}(element.key()); + seed = combine(seed, h); + seed = combine(seed, hash(element.value())); + } + return seed; + } + + case BasicJsonType::value_t::array: + { + auto seed = combine(type, j.size()); + for (const auto& element : j) + { + seed = combine(seed, hash(element)); + } + return seed; + } + + case BasicJsonType::value_t::string: + { + const auto h = std::hash {}(j.template get_ref()); + return combine(type, h); + } + + case BasicJsonType::value_t::boolean: + { + const auto h = std::hash {}(j.template get()); + return combine(type, h); + } + + case BasicJsonType::value_t::number_integer: + { + const auto h = std::hash {}(j.template get()); + return combine(type, h); + } + + case BasicJsonType::value_t::number_unsigned: + { + const auto h = std::hash {}(j.template get()); + return combine(type, h); + } + + case BasicJsonType::value_t::number_float: + { + const auto h = std::hash {}(j.template get()); + return combine(type, h); + } + + case BasicJsonType::value_t::binary: + { + auto seed = combine(type, j.get_binary().size()); + const auto h = std::hash {}(j.get_binary().has_subtype()); + seed = combine(seed, h); + seed = combine(seed, static_cast(j.get_binary().subtype())); + for (const auto byte : j.get_binary()) + { + seed = combine(seed, std::hash {}(byte)); + } + return seed; + } + + default: // LCOV_EXCL_LINE + JSON_ASSERT(false); // NOLINT(cert-dcl03-c,hicpp-static-assert,misc-static-assert) LCOV_EXCL_LINE + return 0; // LCOV_EXCL_LINE + } +} + +} // namespace detail +} // namespace nlohmann + +// #include + + +#include // generate_n +#include // array +#include // ldexp +#include // size_t +#include // uint8_t, uint16_t, uint32_t, uint64_t +#include // snprintf +#include // memcpy +#include // back_inserter +#include // numeric_limits +#include // char_traits, string +#include // make_pair, move +#include // vector + +// #include + +// #include + + +#include // array +#include // size_t +#include // strlen +#include // begin, end, iterator_traits, random_access_iterator_tag, distance, next +#include // shared_ptr, make_shared, addressof +#include // accumulate +#include // string, char_traits +#include // enable_if, is_base_of, is_pointer, is_integral, remove_pointer +#include // pair, declval + +#ifndef JSON_NO_IO + #include // FILE * + #include // istream +#endif // JSON_NO_IO + +// #include + +// #include + + +namespace nlohmann +{ +namespace detail +{ +/// the supported input formats +enum class input_format_t { json, cbor, msgpack, ubjson, bson }; + +//////////////////// +// input adapters // +//////////////////// + +#ifndef JSON_NO_IO +/*! +Input adapter for stdio file access. This adapter read only 1 byte and do not use any + buffer. This adapter is a very low level adapter. +*/ +class file_input_adapter +{ + public: + using char_type = char; + + JSON_HEDLEY_NON_NULL(2) + explicit file_input_adapter(std::FILE* f) noexcept + : m_file(f) + {} + + // make class move-only + file_input_adapter(const file_input_adapter&) = delete; + file_input_adapter(file_input_adapter&&) noexcept = default; + file_input_adapter& operator=(const file_input_adapter&) = delete; + file_input_adapter& operator=(file_input_adapter&&) = delete; + ~file_input_adapter() = default; + + std::char_traits::int_type get_character() noexcept + { + return std::fgetc(m_file); + } + + private: + /// the file pointer to read from + std::FILE* m_file; +}; + + +/*! +Input adapter for a (caching) istream. Ignores a UFT Byte Order Mark at +beginning of input. Does not support changing the underlying std::streambuf +in mid-input. Maintains underlying std::istream and std::streambuf to support +subsequent use of standard std::istream operations to process any input +characters following those used in parsing the JSON input. Clears the +std::istream flags; any input errors (e.g., EOF) will be detected by the first +subsequent call for input from the std::istream. +*/ +class input_stream_adapter +{ + public: + using char_type = char; + + ~input_stream_adapter() + { + // clear stream flags; we use underlying streambuf I/O, do not + // maintain ifstream flags, except eof + if (is != nullptr) + { + is->clear(is->rdstate() & std::ios::eofbit); + } + } + + explicit input_stream_adapter(std::istream& i) + : is(&i), sb(i.rdbuf()) + {} + + // delete because of pointer members + input_stream_adapter(const input_stream_adapter&) = delete; + input_stream_adapter& operator=(input_stream_adapter&) = delete; + input_stream_adapter& operator=(input_stream_adapter&&) = delete; + + input_stream_adapter(input_stream_adapter&& rhs) noexcept + : is(rhs.is), sb(rhs.sb) + { + rhs.is = nullptr; + rhs.sb = nullptr; + } + + // std::istream/std::streambuf use std::char_traits::to_int_type, to + // ensure that std::char_traits::eof() and the character 0xFF do not + // end up as the same value, e.g. 0xFFFFFFFF. + std::char_traits::int_type get_character() + { + auto res = sb->sbumpc(); + // set eof manually, as we don't use the istream interface. + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(res == std::char_traits::eof())) + { + is->clear(is->rdstate() | std::ios::eofbit); + } + return res; + } + + private: + /// the associated input stream + std::istream* is = nullptr; + std::streambuf* sb = nullptr; +}; +#endif // JSON_NO_IO + +// General-purpose iterator-based adapter. It might not be as fast as +// theoretically possible for some containers, but it is extremely versatile. +template +class iterator_input_adapter +{ + public: + using char_type = typename std::iterator_traits::value_type; + + iterator_input_adapter(IteratorType first, IteratorType last) + : current(std::move(first)), end(std::move(last)) + {} + + typename std::char_traits::int_type get_character() + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_LIKELY(current != end)) + { + auto result = std::char_traits::to_int_type(*current); + std::advance(current, 1); + return result; + } + + return std::char_traits::eof(); + } + + private: + IteratorType current; + IteratorType end; + + template + friend struct wide_string_input_helper; + + bool empty() const + { + return current == end; + } +}; + + +template +struct wide_string_input_helper; + +template +struct wide_string_input_helper +{ + // UTF-32 + static void fill_buffer(BaseInputAdapter& input, + std::array::int_type, 4>& utf8_bytes, + size_t& utf8_bytes_index, + size_t& utf8_bytes_filled) + { + utf8_bytes_index = 0; + + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(input.empty())) + { + utf8_bytes[0] = std::char_traits::eof(); + utf8_bytes_filled = 1; + } + else + { + // get the current character + const auto wc = input.get_character(); + + // UTF-32 to UTF-8 encoding + if (wc < 0x80) + { + utf8_bytes[0] = static_cast::int_type>(wc); + utf8_bytes_filled = 1; + } + else if (wc <= 0x7FF) + { + utf8_bytes[0] = static_cast::int_type>(0xC0u | ((static_cast(wc) >> 6u) & 0x1Fu)); + utf8_bytes[1] = static_cast::int_type>(0x80u | (static_cast(wc) & 0x3Fu)); + utf8_bytes_filled = 2; + } + else if (wc <= 0xFFFF) + { + utf8_bytes[0] = static_cast::int_type>(0xE0u | ((static_cast(wc) >> 12u) & 0x0Fu)); + utf8_bytes[1] = static_cast::int_type>(0x80u | ((static_cast(wc) >> 6u) & 0x3Fu)); + utf8_bytes[2] = static_cast::int_type>(0x80u | (static_cast(wc) & 0x3Fu)); + utf8_bytes_filled = 3; + } + else if (wc <= 0x10FFFF) + { + utf8_bytes[0] = static_cast::int_type>(0xF0u | ((static_cast(wc) >> 18u) & 0x07u)); + utf8_bytes[1] = static_cast::int_type>(0x80u | ((static_cast(wc) >> 12u) & 0x3Fu)); + utf8_bytes[2] = static_cast::int_type>(0x80u | ((static_cast(wc) >> 6u) & 0x3Fu)); + utf8_bytes[3] = static_cast::int_type>(0x80u | (static_cast(wc) & 0x3Fu)); + utf8_bytes_filled = 4; + } + else + { + // unknown character + utf8_bytes[0] = static_cast::int_type>(wc); + utf8_bytes_filled = 1; + } + } + } +}; + +template +struct wide_string_input_helper +{ + // UTF-16 + static void fill_buffer(BaseInputAdapter& input, + std::array::int_type, 4>& utf8_bytes, + size_t& utf8_bytes_index, + size_t& utf8_bytes_filled) + { + utf8_bytes_index = 0; + + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(input.empty())) + { + utf8_bytes[0] = std::char_traits::eof(); + utf8_bytes_filled = 1; + } + else + { + // get the current character + const auto wc = input.get_character(); + + // UTF-16 to UTF-8 encoding + if (wc < 0x80) + { + utf8_bytes[0] = static_cast::int_type>(wc); + utf8_bytes_filled = 1; + } + else if (wc <= 0x7FF) + { + utf8_bytes[0] = static_cast::int_type>(0xC0u | ((static_cast(wc) >> 6u))); + utf8_bytes[1] = static_cast::int_type>(0x80u | (static_cast(wc) & 0x3Fu)); + utf8_bytes_filled = 2; + } + else if (0xD800 > wc || wc >= 0xE000) + { + utf8_bytes[0] = static_cast::int_type>(0xE0u | ((static_cast(wc) >> 12u))); + utf8_bytes[1] = static_cast::int_type>(0x80u | ((static_cast(wc) >> 6u) & 0x3Fu)); + utf8_bytes[2] = static_cast::int_type>(0x80u | (static_cast(wc) & 0x3Fu)); + utf8_bytes_filled = 3; + } + else + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!input.empty())) + { + const auto wc2 = static_cast(input.get_character()); + const auto charcode = 0x10000u + (((static_cast(wc) & 0x3FFu) << 10u) | (wc2 & 0x3FFu)); + utf8_bytes[0] = static_cast::int_type>(0xF0u | (charcode >> 18u)); + utf8_bytes[1] = static_cast::int_type>(0x80u | ((charcode >> 12u) & 0x3Fu)); + utf8_bytes[2] = static_cast::int_type>(0x80u | ((charcode >> 6u) & 0x3Fu)); + utf8_bytes[3] = static_cast::int_type>(0x80u | (charcode & 0x3Fu)); + utf8_bytes_filled = 4; + } + else + { + utf8_bytes[0] = static_cast::int_type>(wc); + utf8_bytes_filled = 1; + } + } + } + } +}; + +// Wraps another input apdater to convert wide character types into individual bytes. +template +class wide_string_input_adapter +{ + public: + using char_type = char; + + wide_string_input_adapter(BaseInputAdapter base) + : base_adapter(base) {} + + typename std::char_traits::int_type get_character() noexcept + { + // check if buffer needs to be filled + if (utf8_bytes_index == utf8_bytes_filled) + { + fill_buffer(); + + JSON_ASSERT(utf8_bytes_filled > 0); + JSON_ASSERT(utf8_bytes_index == 0); + } + + // use buffer + JSON_ASSERT(utf8_bytes_filled > 0); + JSON_ASSERT(utf8_bytes_index < utf8_bytes_filled); + return utf8_bytes[utf8_bytes_index++]; + } + + private: + BaseInputAdapter base_adapter; + + template + void fill_buffer() + { + wide_string_input_helper::fill_buffer(base_adapter, utf8_bytes, utf8_bytes_index, utf8_bytes_filled); + } + + /// a buffer for UTF-8 bytes + std::array::int_type, 4> utf8_bytes = {{0, 0, 0, 0}}; + + /// index to the utf8_codes array for the next valid byte + std::size_t utf8_bytes_index = 0; + /// number of valid bytes in the utf8_codes array + std::size_t utf8_bytes_filled = 0; +}; + + +template +struct iterator_input_adapter_factory +{ + using iterator_type = IteratorType; + using char_type = typename std::iterator_traits::value_type; + using adapter_type = iterator_input_adapter; + + static adapter_type create(IteratorType first, IteratorType last) + { + return adapter_type(std::move(first), std::move(last)); + } +}; + +template +struct is_iterator_of_multibyte +{ + using value_type = typename std::iterator_traits::value_type; + enum + { + value = sizeof(value_type) > 1 + }; +}; + +template +struct iterator_input_adapter_factory::value>> +{ + using iterator_type = IteratorType; + using char_type = typename std::iterator_traits::value_type; + using base_adapter_type = iterator_input_adapter; + using adapter_type = wide_string_input_adapter; + + static adapter_type create(IteratorType first, IteratorType last) + { + return adapter_type(base_adapter_type(std::move(first), std::move(last))); + } +}; + +// General purpose iterator-based input +template +typename iterator_input_adapter_factory::adapter_type input_adapter(IteratorType first, IteratorType last) +{ + using factory_type = iterator_input_adapter_factory; + return factory_type::create(first, last); +} + +// Convenience shorthand from container to iterator +// Enables ADL on begin(container) and end(container) +// Encloses the using declarations in namespace for not to leak them to outside scope + +namespace container_input_adapter_factory_impl +{ + +using std::begin; +using std::end; + +template +struct container_input_adapter_factory {}; + +template +struct container_input_adapter_factory< ContainerType, + void_t()), end(std::declval()))>> + { + using adapter_type = decltype(input_adapter(begin(std::declval()), end(std::declval()))); + + static adapter_type create(const ContainerType& container) +{ + return input_adapter(begin(container), end(container)); +} + }; + +} // namespace container_input_adapter_factory_impl + +template +typename container_input_adapter_factory_impl::container_input_adapter_factory::adapter_type input_adapter(const ContainerType& container) +{ + return container_input_adapter_factory_impl::container_input_adapter_factory::create(container); +} + +#ifndef JSON_NO_IO +// Special cases with fast paths +inline file_input_adapter input_adapter(std::FILE* file) +{ + return file_input_adapter(file); +} + +inline input_stream_adapter input_adapter(std::istream& stream) +{ + return input_stream_adapter(stream); +} + +inline input_stream_adapter input_adapter(std::istream&& stream) +{ + return input_stream_adapter(stream); +} +#endif // JSON_NO_IO + +using contiguous_bytes_input_adapter = decltype(input_adapter(std::declval(), std::declval())); + +// Null-delimited strings, and the like. +template < typename CharT, + typename std::enable_if < + std::is_pointer::value&& + !std::is_array::value&& + std::is_integral::type>::value&& + sizeof(typename std::remove_pointer::type) == 1, + int >::type = 0 > +contiguous_bytes_input_adapter input_adapter(CharT b) +{ + auto length = std::strlen(reinterpret_cast(b)); + const auto* ptr = reinterpret_cast(b); + return input_adapter(ptr, ptr + length); +} + +template +auto input_adapter(T (&array)[N]) -> decltype(input_adapter(array, array + N)) // NOLINT(cppcoreguidelines-avoid-c-arrays,hicpp-avoid-c-arrays,modernize-avoid-c-arrays) +{ + return input_adapter(array, array + N); +} + +// This class only handles inputs of input_buffer_adapter type. +// It's required so that expressions like {ptr, len} can be implicitly cast +// to the correct adapter. +class span_input_adapter +{ + public: + template < typename CharT, + typename std::enable_if < + std::is_pointer::value&& + std::is_integral::type>::value&& + sizeof(typename std::remove_pointer::type) == 1, + int >::type = 0 > + span_input_adapter(CharT b, std::size_t l) + : ia(reinterpret_cast(b), reinterpret_cast(b) + l) {} + + template::iterator_category, std::random_access_iterator_tag>::value, + int>::type = 0> + span_input_adapter(IteratorType first, IteratorType last) + : ia(input_adapter(first, last)) {} + + contiguous_bytes_input_adapter&& get() + { + return std::move(ia); // NOLINT(hicpp-move-const-arg,performance-move-const-arg) + } + + private: + contiguous_bytes_input_adapter ia; +}; +} // namespace detail +} // namespace nlohmann + +// #include + + +#include +#include // string +#include // move +#include // vector + +// #include + +// #include + + +namespace nlohmann +{ + +/*! +@brief SAX interface + +This class describes the SAX interface used by @ref nlohmann::json::sax_parse. +Each function is called in different situations while the input is parsed. The +boolean return value informs the parser whether to continue processing the +input. +*/ +template +struct json_sax +{ + using number_integer_t = typename BasicJsonType::number_integer_t; + using number_unsigned_t = typename BasicJsonType::number_unsigned_t; + using number_float_t = typename BasicJsonType::number_float_t; + using string_t = typename BasicJsonType::string_t; + using binary_t = typename BasicJsonType::binary_t; + + /*! + @brief a null value was read + @return whether parsing should proceed + */ + virtual bool null() = 0; + + /*! + @brief a boolean value was read + @param[in] val boolean value + @return whether parsing should proceed + */ + virtual bool boolean(bool val) = 0; + + /*! + @brief an integer number was read + @param[in] val integer value + @return whether parsing should proceed + */ + virtual bool number_integer(number_integer_t val) = 0; + + /*! + @brief an unsigned integer number was read + @param[in] val unsigned integer value + @return whether parsing should proceed + */ + virtual bool number_unsigned(number_unsigned_t val) = 0; + + /*! + @brief a floating-point number was read + @param[in] val floating-point value + @param[in] s raw token value + @return whether parsing should proceed + */ + virtual bool number_float(number_float_t val, const string_t& s) = 0; + + /*! + @brief a string value was read + @param[in] val string value + @return whether parsing should proceed + @note It is safe to move the passed string value. + */ + virtual bool string(string_t& val) = 0; + + /*! + @brief a binary value was read + @param[in] val binary value + @return whether parsing should proceed + @note It is safe to move the passed binary value. + */ + virtual bool binary(binary_t& val) = 0; + + /*! + @brief the beginning of an object was read + @param[in] elements number of object elements or -1 if unknown + @return whether parsing should proceed + @note binary formats may report the number of elements + */ + virtual bool start_object(std::size_t elements) = 0; + + /*! + @brief an object key was read + @param[in] val object key + @return whether parsing should proceed + @note It is safe to move the passed string. + */ + virtual bool key(string_t& val) = 0; + + /*! + @brief the end of an object was read + @return whether parsing should proceed + */ + virtual bool end_object() = 0; + + /*! + @brief the beginning of an array was read + @param[in] elements number of array elements or -1 if unknown + @return whether parsing should proceed + @note binary formats may report the number of elements + */ + virtual bool start_array(std::size_t elements) = 0; + + /*! + @brief the end of an array was read + @return whether parsing should proceed + */ + virtual bool end_array() = 0; + + /*! + @brief a parse error occurred + @param[in] position the position in the input where the error occurs + @param[in] last_token the last read token + @param[in] ex an exception object describing the error + @return whether parsing should proceed (must return false) + */ + virtual bool parse_error(std::size_t position, + const std::string& last_token, + const detail::exception& ex) = 0; + + json_sax() = default; + json_sax(const json_sax&) = default; + json_sax(json_sax&&) noexcept = default; + json_sax& operator=(const json_sax&) = default; + json_sax& operator=(json_sax&&) noexcept = default; + virtual ~json_sax() = default; +}; + + +namespace detail +{ +/*! +@brief SAX implementation to create a JSON value from SAX events + +This class implements the @ref json_sax interface and processes the SAX events +to create a JSON value which makes it basically a DOM parser. The structure or +hierarchy of the JSON value is managed by the stack `ref_stack` which contains +a pointer to the respective array or object for each recursion depth. + +After successful parsing, the value that is passed by reference to the +constructor contains the parsed value. + +@tparam BasicJsonType the JSON type +*/ +template +class json_sax_dom_parser +{ + public: + using number_integer_t = typename BasicJsonType::number_integer_t; + using number_unsigned_t = typename BasicJsonType::number_unsigned_t; + using number_float_t = typename BasicJsonType::number_float_t; + using string_t = typename BasicJsonType::string_t; + using binary_t = typename BasicJsonType::binary_t; + + /*! + @param[in,out] r reference to a JSON value that is manipulated while + parsing + @param[in] allow_exceptions_ whether parse errors yield exceptions + */ + explicit json_sax_dom_parser(BasicJsonType& r, const bool allow_exceptions_ = true) + : root(r), allow_exceptions(allow_exceptions_) + {} + + // make class move-only + json_sax_dom_parser(const json_sax_dom_parser&) = delete; + json_sax_dom_parser(json_sax_dom_parser&&) = default; // NOLINT(hicpp-noexcept-move,performance-noexcept-move-constructor) + json_sax_dom_parser& operator=(const json_sax_dom_parser&) = delete; + json_sax_dom_parser& operator=(json_sax_dom_parser&&) = default; // NOLINT(hicpp-noexcept-move,performance-noexcept-move-constructor) + ~json_sax_dom_parser() = default; + + bool null() + { + handle_value(nullptr); + return true; + } + + bool boolean(bool val) + { + handle_value(val); + return true; + } + + bool number_integer(number_integer_t val) + { + handle_value(val); + return true; + } + + bool number_unsigned(number_unsigned_t val) + { + handle_value(val); + return true; + } + + bool number_float(number_float_t val, const string_t& /*unused*/) + { + handle_value(val); + return true; + } + + bool string(string_t& val) + { + handle_value(val); + return true; + } + + bool binary(binary_t& val) + { + handle_value(std::move(val)); + return true; + } + + bool start_object(std::size_t len) + { + ref_stack.push_back(handle_value(BasicJsonType::value_t::object)); + + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(len != static_cast(-1) && len > ref_stack.back()->max_size())) + { + JSON_THROW(out_of_range::create(408, "excessive object size: " + std::to_string(len), *ref_stack.back())); + } + + return true; + } + + bool key(string_t& val) + { + // add null at given key and store the reference for later + object_element = &(ref_stack.back()->m_value.object->operator[](val)); + return true; + } + + bool end_object() + { + ref_stack.back()->set_parents(); + ref_stack.pop_back(); + return true; + } + + bool start_array(std::size_t len) + { + ref_stack.push_back(handle_value(BasicJsonType::value_t::array)); + + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(len != static_cast(-1) && len > ref_stack.back()->max_size())) + { + JSON_THROW(out_of_range::create(408, "excessive array size: " + std::to_string(len), *ref_stack.back())); + } + + return true; + } + + bool end_array() + { + ref_stack.back()->set_parents(); + ref_stack.pop_back(); + return true; + } + + template + bool parse_error(std::size_t /*unused*/, const std::string& /*unused*/, + const Exception& ex) + { + errored = true; + static_cast(ex); + if (allow_exceptions) + { + JSON_THROW(ex); + } + return false; + } + + constexpr bool is_errored() const + { + return errored; + } + + private: + /*! + @invariant If the ref stack is empty, then the passed value will be the new + root. + @invariant If the ref stack contains a value, then it is an array or an + object to which we can add elements + */ + template + JSON_HEDLEY_RETURNS_NON_NULL + BasicJsonType* handle_value(Value&& v) + { + if (ref_stack.empty()) + { + root = BasicJsonType(std::forward(v)); + return &root; + } + + JSON_ASSERT(ref_stack.back()->is_array() || ref_stack.back()->is_object()); + + if (ref_stack.back()->is_array()) + { + ref_stack.back()->m_value.array->emplace_back(std::forward(v)); + return &(ref_stack.back()->m_value.array->back()); + } + + JSON_ASSERT(ref_stack.back()->is_object()); + JSON_ASSERT(object_element); + *object_element = BasicJsonType(std::forward(v)); + return object_element; + } + + /// the parsed JSON value + BasicJsonType& root; + /// stack to model hierarchy of values + std::vector ref_stack {}; + /// helper to hold the reference for the next object element + BasicJsonType* object_element = nullptr; + /// whether a syntax error occurred + bool errored = false; + /// whether to throw exceptions in case of errors + const bool allow_exceptions = true; +}; + +template +class json_sax_dom_callback_parser +{ + public: + using number_integer_t = typename BasicJsonType::number_integer_t; + using number_unsigned_t = typename BasicJsonType::number_unsigned_t; + using number_float_t = typename BasicJsonType::number_float_t; + using string_t = typename BasicJsonType::string_t; + using binary_t = typename BasicJsonType::binary_t; + using parser_callback_t = typename BasicJsonType::parser_callback_t; + using parse_event_t = typename BasicJsonType::parse_event_t; + + json_sax_dom_callback_parser(BasicJsonType& r, + const parser_callback_t cb, + const bool allow_exceptions_ = true) + : root(r), callback(cb), allow_exceptions(allow_exceptions_) + { + keep_stack.push_back(true); + } + + // make class move-only + json_sax_dom_callback_parser(const json_sax_dom_callback_parser&) = delete; + json_sax_dom_callback_parser(json_sax_dom_callback_parser&&) = default; // NOLINT(hicpp-noexcept-move,performance-noexcept-move-constructor) + json_sax_dom_callback_parser& operator=(const json_sax_dom_callback_parser&) = delete; + json_sax_dom_callback_parser& operator=(json_sax_dom_callback_parser&&) = default; // NOLINT(hicpp-noexcept-move,performance-noexcept-move-constructor) + ~json_sax_dom_callback_parser() = default; + + bool null() + { + handle_value(nullptr); + return true; + } + + bool boolean(bool val) + { + handle_value(val); + return true; + } + + bool number_integer(number_integer_t val) + { + handle_value(val); + return true; + } + + bool number_unsigned(number_unsigned_t val) + { + handle_value(val); + return true; + } + + bool number_float(number_float_t val, const string_t& /*unused*/) + { + handle_value(val); + return true; + } + + bool string(string_t& val) + { + handle_value(val); + return true; + } + + bool binary(binary_t& val) + { + handle_value(std::move(val)); + return true; + } + + bool start_object(std::size_t len) + { + // check callback for object start + const bool keep = callback(static_cast(ref_stack.size()), parse_event_t::object_start, discarded); + keep_stack.push_back(keep); + + auto val = handle_value(BasicJsonType::value_t::object, true); + ref_stack.push_back(val.second); + + // check object limit + if (ref_stack.back() && JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(len != static_cast(-1) && len > ref_stack.back()->max_size())) + { + JSON_THROW(out_of_range::create(408, "excessive object size: " + std::to_string(len), *ref_stack.back())); + } + + return true; + } + + bool key(string_t& val) + { + BasicJsonType k = BasicJsonType(val); + + // check callback for key + const bool keep = callback(static_cast(ref_stack.size()), parse_event_t::key, k); + key_keep_stack.push_back(keep); + + // add discarded value at given key and store the reference for later + if (keep && ref_stack.back()) + { + object_element = &(ref_stack.back()->m_value.object->operator[](val) = discarded); + } + + return true; + } + + bool end_object() + { + if (ref_stack.back()) + { + if (!callback(static_cast(ref_stack.size()) - 1, parse_event_t::object_end, *ref_stack.back())) + { + // discard object + *ref_stack.back() = discarded; + } + else + { + ref_stack.back()->set_parents(); + } + } + + JSON_ASSERT(!ref_stack.empty()); + JSON_ASSERT(!keep_stack.empty()); + ref_stack.pop_back(); + keep_stack.pop_back(); + + if (!ref_stack.empty() && ref_stack.back() && ref_stack.back()->is_structured()) + { + // remove discarded value + for (auto it = ref_stack.back()->begin(); it != ref_stack.back()->end(); ++it) + { + if (it->is_discarded()) + { + ref_stack.back()->erase(it); + break; + } + } + } + + return true; + } + + bool start_array(std::size_t len) + { + const bool keep = callback(static_cast(ref_stack.size()), parse_event_t::array_start, discarded); + keep_stack.push_back(keep); + + auto val = handle_value(BasicJsonType::value_t::array, true); + ref_stack.push_back(val.second); + + // check array limit + if (ref_stack.back() && JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(len != static_cast(-1) && len > ref_stack.back()->max_size())) + { + JSON_THROW(out_of_range::create(408, "excessive array size: " + std::to_string(len), *ref_stack.back())); + } + + return true; + } + + bool end_array() + { + bool keep = true; + + if (ref_stack.back()) + { + keep = callback(static_cast(ref_stack.size()) - 1, parse_event_t::array_end, *ref_stack.back()); + if (keep) + { + ref_stack.back()->set_parents(); + } + else + { + // discard array + *ref_stack.back() = discarded; + } + } + + JSON_ASSERT(!ref_stack.empty()); + JSON_ASSERT(!keep_stack.empty()); + ref_stack.pop_back(); + keep_stack.pop_back(); + + // remove discarded value + if (!keep && !ref_stack.empty() && ref_stack.back()->is_array()) + { + ref_stack.back()->m_value.array->pop_back(); + } + + return true; + } + + template + bool parse_error(std::size_t /*unused*/, const std::string& /*unused*/, + const Exception& ex) + { + errored = true; + static_cast(ex); + if (allow_exceptions) + { + JSON_THROW(ex); + } + return false; + } + + constexpr bool is_errored() const + { + return errored; + } + + private: + /*! + @param[in] v value to add to the JSON value we build during parsing + @param[in] skip_callback whether we should skip calling the callback + function; this is required after start_array() and + start_object() SAX events, because otherwise we would call the + callback function with an empty array or object, respectively. + + @invariant If the ref stack is empty, then the passed value will be the new + root. + @invariant If the ref stack contains a value, then it is an array or an + object to which we can add elements + + @return pair of boolean (whether value should be kept) and pointer (to the + passed value in the ref_stack hierarchy; nullptr if not kept) + */ + template + std::pair handle_value(Value&& v, const bool skip_callback = false) + { + JSON_ASSERT(!keep_stack.empty()); + + // do not handle this value if we know it would be added to a discarded + // container + if (!keep_stack.back()) + { + return {false, nullptr}; + } + + // create value + auto value = BasicJsonType(std::forward(v)); + + // check callback + const bool keep = skip_callback || callback(static_cast(ref_stack.size()), parse_event_t::value, value); + + // do not handle this value if we just learnt it shall be discarded + if (!keep) + { + return {false, nullptr}; + } + + if (ref_stack.empty()) + { + root = std::move(value); + return {true, &root}; + } + + // skip this value if we already decided to skip the parent + // (https://github.com/nlohmann/json/issues/971#issuecomment-413678360) + if (!ref_stack.back()) + { + return {false, nullptr}; + } + + // we now only expect arrays and objects + JSON_ASSERT(ref_stack.back()->is_array() || ref_stack.back()->is_object()); + + // array + if (ref_stack.back()->is_array()) + { + ref_stack.back()->m_value.array->emplace_back(std::move(value)); + return {true, &(ref_stack.back()->m_value.array->back())}; + } + + // object + JSON_ASSERT(ref_stack.back()->is_object()); + // check if we should store an element for the current key + JSON_ASSERT(!key_keep_stack.empty()); + const bool store_element = key_keep_stack.back(); + key_keep_stack.pop_back(); + + if (!store_element) + { + return {false, nullptr}; + } + + JSON_ASSERT(object_element); + *object_element = std::move(value); + return {true, object_element}; + } + + /// the parsed JSON value + BasicJsonType& root; + /// stack to model hierarchy of values + std::vector ref_stack {}; + /// stack to manage which values to keep + std::vector keep_stack {}; + /// stack to manage which object keys to keep + std::vector key_keep_stack {}; + /// helper to hold the reference for the next object element + BasicJsonType* object_element = nullptr; + /// whether a syntax error occurred + bool errored = false; + /// callback function + const parser_callback_t callback = nullptr; + /// whether to throw exceptions in case of errors + const bool allow_exceptions = true; + /// a discarded value for the callback + BasicJsonType discarded = BasicJsonType::value_t::discarded; +}; + +template +class json_sax_acceptor +{ + public: + using number_integer_t = typename BasicJsonType::number_integer_t; + using number_unsigned_t = typename BasicJsonType::number_unsigned_t; + using number_float_t = typename BasicJsonType::number_float_t; + using string_t = typename BasicJsonType::string_t; + using binary_t = typename BasicJsonType::binary_t; + + bool null() + { + return true; + } + + bool boolean(bool /*unused*/) + { + return true; + } + + bool number_integer(number_integer_t /*unused*/) + { + return true; + } + + bool number_unsigned(number_unsigned_t /*unused*/) + { + return true; + } + + bool number_float(number_float_t /*unused*/, const string_t& /*unused*/) + { + return true; + } + + bool string(string_t& /*unused*/) + { + return true; + } + + bool binary(binary_t& /*unused*/) + { + return true; + } + + bool start_object(std::size_t /*unused*/ = static_cast(-1)) + { + return true; + } + + bool key(string_t& /*unused*/) + { + return true; + } + + bool end_object() + { + return true; + } + + bool start_array(std::size_t /*unused*/ = static_cast(-1)) + { + return true; + } + + bool end_array() + { + return true; + } + + bool parse_error(std::size_t /*unused*/, const std::string& /*unused*/, const detail::exception& /*unused*/) + { + return false; + } +}; +} // namespace detail + +} // namespace nlohmann + +// #include + + +#include // array +#include // localeconv +#include // size_t +#include // snprintf +#include // strtof, strtod, strtold, strtoll, strtoull +#include // initializer_list +#include // char_traits, string +#include // move +#include // vector + +// #include + +// #include + +// #include + + +namespace nlohmann +{ +namespace detail +{ +/////////// +// lexer // +/////////// + +template +class lexer_base +{ + public: + /// token types for the parser + enum class token_type + { + uninitialized, ///< indicating the scanner is uninitialized + literal_true, ///< the `true` literal + literal_false, ///< the `false` literal + literal_null, ///< the `null` literal + value_string, ///< a string -- use get_string() for actual value + value_unsigned, ///< an unsigned integer -- use get_number_unsigned() for actual value + value_integer, ///< a signed integer -- use get_number_integer() for actual value + value_float, ///< an floating point number -- use get_number_float() for actual value + begin_array, ///< the character for array begin `[` + begin_object, ///< the character for object begin `{` + end_array, ///< the character for array end `]` + end_object, ///< the character for object end `}` + name_separator, ///< the name separator `:` + value_separator, ///< the value separator `,` + parse_error, ///< indicating a parse error + end_of_input, ///< indicating the end of the input buffer + literal_or_value ///< a literal or the begin of a value (only for diagnostics) + }; + + /// return name of values of type token_type (only used for errors) + JSON_HEDLEY_RETURNS_NON_NULL + JSON_HEDLEY_CONST + static const char* token_type_name(const token_type t) noexcept + { + switch (t) + { + case token_type::uninitialized: + return ""; + case token_type::literal_true: + return "true literal"; + case token_type::literal_false: + return "false literal"; + case token_type::literal_null: + return "null literal"; + case token_type::value_string: + return "string literal"; + case token_type::value_unsigned: + case token_type::value_integer: + case token_type::value_float: + return "number literal"; + case token_type::begin_array: + return "'['"; + case token_type::begin_object: + return "'{'"; + case token_type::end_array: + return "']'"; + case token_type::end_object: + return "'}'"; + case token_type::name_separator: + return "':'"; + case token_type::value_separator: + return "','"; + case token_type::parse_error: + return ""; + case token_type::end_of_input: + return "end of input"; + case token_type::literal_or_value: + return "'[', '{', or a literal"; + // LCOV_EXCL_START + default: // catch non-enum values + return "unknown token"; + // LCOV_EXCL_STOP + } + } +}; +/*! +@brief lexical analysis + +This class organizes the lexical analysis during JSON deserialization. +*/ +template +class lexer : public lexer_base +{ + using number_integer_t = typename BasicJsonType::number_integer_t; + using number_unsigned_t = typename BasicJsonType::number_unsigned_t; + using number_float_t = typename BasicJsonType::number_float_t; + using string_t = typename BasicJsonType::string_t; + using char_type = typename InputAdapterType::char_type; + using char_int_type = typename std::char_traits::int_type; + + public: + using token_type = typename lexer_base::token_type; + + explicit lexer(InputAdapterType&& adapter, bool ignore_comments_ = false) noexcept + : ia(std::move(adapter)) + , ignore_comments(ignore_comments_) + , decimal_point_char(static_cast(get_decimal_point())) + {} + + // delete because of pointer members + lexer(const lexer&) = delete; + lexer(lexer&&) = default; // NOLINT(hicpp-noexcept-move,performance-noexcept-move-constructor) + lexer& operator=(lexer&) = delete; + lexer& operator=(lexer&&) = default; // NOLINT(hicpp-noexcept-move,performance-noexcept-move-constructor) + ~lexer() = default; + + private: + ///////////////////// + // locales + ///////////////////// + + /// return the locale-dependent decimal point + JSON_HEDLEY_PURE + static char get_decimal_point() noexcept + { + const auto* loc = localeconv(); + JSON_ASSERT(loc != nullptr); + return (loc->decimal_point == nullptr) ? '.' : *(loc->decimal_point); + } + + ///////////////////// + // scan functions + ///////////////////// + + /*! + @brief get codepoint from 4 hex characters following `\u` + + For input "\u c1 c2 c3 c4" the codepoint is: + (c1 * 0x1000) + (c2 * 0x0100) + (c3 * 0x0010) + c4 + = (c1 << 12) + (c2 << 8) + (c3 << 4) + (c4 << 0) + + Furthermore, the possible characters '0'..'9', 'A'..'F', and 'a'..'f' + must be converted to the integers 0x0..0x9, 0xA..0xF, 0xA..0xF, resp. The + conversion is done by subtracting the offset (0x30, 0x37, and 0x57) + between the ASCII value of the character and the desired integer value. + + @return codepoint (0x0000..0xFFFF) or -1 in case of an error (e.g. EOF or + non-hex character) + */ + int get_codepoint() + { + // this function only makes sense after reading `\u` + JSON_ASSERT(current == 'u'); + int codepoint = 0; + + const auto factors = { 12u, 8u, 4u, 0u }; + for (const auto factor : factors) + { + get(); + + if (current >= '0' && current <= '9') + { + codepoint += static_cast((static_cast(current) - 0x30u) << factor); + } + else if (current >= 'A' && current <= 'F') + { + codepoint += static_cast((static_cast(current) - 0x37u) << factor); + } + else if (current >= 'a' && current <= 'f') + { + codepoint += static_cast((static_cast(current) - 0x57u) << factor); + } + else + { + return -1; + } + } + + JSON_ASSERT(0x0000 <= codepoint && codepoint <= 0xFFFF); + return codepoint; + } + + /*! + @brief check if the next byte(s) are inside a given range + + Adds the current byte and, for each passed range, reads a new byte and + checks if it is inside the range. If a violation was detected, set up an + error message and return false. Otherwise, return true. + + @param[in] ranges list of integers; interpreted as list of pairs of + inclusive lower and upper bound, respectively + + @pre The passed list @a ranges must have 2, 4, or 6 elements; that is, + 1, 2, or 3 pairs. This precondition is enforced by an assertion. + + @return true if and only if no range violation was detected + */ + bool next_byte_in_range(std::initializer_list ranges) + { + JSON_ASSERT(ranges.size() == 2 || ranges.size() == 4 || ranges.size() == 6); + add(current); + + for (auto range = ranges.begin(); range != ranges.end(); ++range) + { + get(); + if (JSON_HEDLEY_LIKELY(*range <= current && current <= *(++range))) + { + add(current); + } + else + { + error_message = "invalid string: ill-formed UTF-8 byte"; + return false; + } + } + + return true; + } + + /*! + @brief scan a string literal + + This function scans a string according to Sect. 7 of RFC 8259. While + scanning, bytes are escaped and copied into buffer token_buffer. Then the + function returns successfully, token_buffer is *not* null-terminated (as it + may contain \0 bytes), and token_buffer.size() is the number of bytes in the + string. + + @return token_type::value_string if string could be successfully scanned, + token_type::parse_error otherwise + + @note In case of errors, variable error_message contains a textual + description. + */ + token_type scan_string() + { + // reset token_buffer (ignore opening quote) + reset(); + + // we entered the function by reading an open quote + JSON_ASSERT(current == '\"'); + + while (true) + { + // get next character + switch (get()) + { + // end of file while parsing string + case std::char_traits::eof(): + { + error_message = "invalid string: missing closing quote"; + return token_type::parse_error; + } + + // closing quote + case '\"': + { + return token_type::value_string; + } + + // escapes + case '\\': + { + switch (get()) + { + // quotation mark + case '\"': + add('\"'); + break; + // reverse solidus + case '\\': + add('\\'); + break; + // solidus + case '/': + add('/'); + break; + // backspace + case 'b': + add('\b'); + break; + // form feed + case 'f': + add('\f'); + break; + // line feed + case 'n': + add('\n'); + break; + // carriage return + case 'r': + add('\r'); + break; + // tab + case 't': + add('\t'); + break; + + // unicode escapes + case 'u': + { + const int codepoint1 = get_codepoint(); + int codepoint = codepoint1; // start with codepoint1 + + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(codepoint1 == -1)) + { + error_message = "invalid string: '\\u' must be followed by 4 hex digits"; + return token_type::parse_error; + } + + // check if code point is a high surrogate + if (0xD800 <= codepoint1 && codepoint1 <= 0xDBFF) + { + // expect next \uxxxx entry + if (JSON_HEDLEY_LIKELY(get() == '\\' && get() == 'u')) + { + const int codepoint2 = get_codepoint(); + + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(codepoint2 == -1)) + { + error_message = "invalid string: '\\u' must be followed by 4 hex digits"; + return token_type::parse_error; + } + + // check if codepoint2 is a low surrogate + if (JSON_HEDLEY_LIKELY(0xDC00 <= codepoint2 && codepoint2 <= 0xDFFF)) + { + // overwrite codepoint + codepoint = static_cast( + // high surrogate occupies the most significant 22 bits + (static_cast(codepoint1) << 10u) + // low surrogate occupies the least significant 15 bits + + static_cast(codepoint2) + // there is still the 0xD800, 0xDC00 and 0x10000 noise + // in the result, so we have to subtract with: + // (0xD800 << 10) + DC00 - 0x10000 = 0x35FDC00 + - 0x35FDC00u); + } + else + { + error_message = "invalid string: surrogate U+D800..U+DBFF must be followed by U+DC00..U+DFFF"; + return token_type::parse_error; + } + } + else + { + error_message = "invalid string: surrogate U+D800..U+DBFF must be followed by U+DC00..U+DFFF"; + return token_type::parse_error; + } + } + else + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(0xDC00 <= codepoint1 && codepoint1 <= 0xDFFF)) + { + error_message = "invalid string: surrogate U+DC00..U+DFFF must follow U+D800..U+DBFF"; + return token_type::parse_error; + } + } + + // result of the above calculation yields a proper codepoint + JSON_ASSERT(0x00 <= codepoint && codepoint <= 0x10FFFF); + + // translate codepoint into bytes + if (codepoint < 0x80) + { + // 1-byte characters: 0xxxxxxx (ASCII) + add(static_cast(codepoint)); + } + else if (codepoint <= 0x7FF) + { + // 2-byte characters: 110xxxxx 10xxxxxx + add(static_cast(0xC0u | (static_cast(codepoint) >> 6u))); + add(static_cast(0x80u | (static_cast(codepoint) & 0x3Fu))); + } + else if (codepoint <= 0xFFFF) + { + // 3-byte characters: 1110xxxx 10xxxxxx 10xxxxxx + add(static_cast(0xE0u | (static_cast(codepoint) >> 12u))); + add(static_cast(0x80u | ((static_cast(codepoint) >> 6u) & 0x3Fu))); + add(static_cast(0x80u | (static_cast(codepoint) & 0x3Fu))); + } + else + { + // 4-byte characters: 11110xxx 10xxxxxx 10xxxxxx 10xxxxxx + add(static_cast(0xF0u | (static_cast(codepoint) >> 18u))); + add(static_cast(0x80u | ((static_cast(codepoint) >> 12u) & 0x3Fu))); + add(static_cast(0x80u | ((static_cast(codepoint) >> 6u) & 0x3Fu))); + add(static_cast(0x80u | (static_cast(codepoint) & 0x3Fu))); + } + + break; + } + + // other characters after escape + default: + error_message = "invalid string: forbidden character after backslash"; + return token_type::parse_error; + } + + break; + } + + // invalid control characters + case 0x00: + { + error_message = "invalid string: control character U+0000 (NUL) must be escaped to \\u0000"; + return token_type::parse_error; + } + + case 0x01: + { + error_message = "invalid string: control character U+0001 (SOH) must be escaped to \\u0001"; + return token_type::parse_error; + } + + case 0x02: + { + error_message = "invalid string: control character U+0002 (STX) must be escaped to \\u0002"; + return token_type::parse_error; + } + + case 0x03: + { + error_message = "invalid string: control character U+0003 (ETX) must be escaped to \\u0003"; + return token_type::parse_error; + } + + case 0x04: + { + error_message = "invalid string: control character U+0004 (EOT) must be escaped to \\u0004"; + return token_type::parse_error; + } + + case 0x05: + { + error_message = "invalid string: control character U+0005 (ENQ) must be escaped to \\u0005"; + return token_type::parse_error; + } + + case 0x06: + { + error_message = "invalid string: control character U+0006 (ACK) must be escaped to \\u0006"; + return token_type::parse_error; + } + + case 0x07: + { + error_message = "invalid string: control character U+0007 (BEL) must be escaped to \\u0007"; + return token_type::parse_error; + } + + case 0x08: + { + error_message = "invalid string: control character U+0008 (BS) must be escaped to \\u0008 or \\b"; + return token_type::parse_error; + } + + case 0x09: + { + error_message = "invalid string: control character U+0009 (HT) must be escaped to \\u0009 or \\t"; + return token_type::parse_error; + } + + case 0x0A: + { + error_message = "invalid string: control character U+000A (LF) must be escaped to \\u000A or \\n"; + return token_type::parse_error; + } + + case 0x0B: + { + error_message = "invalid string: control character U+000B (VT) must be escaped to \\u000B"; + return token_type::parse_error; + } + + case 0x0C: + { + error_message = "invalid string: control character U+000C (FF) must be escaped to \\u000C or \\f"; + return token_type::parse_error; + } + + case 0x0D: + { + error_message = "invalid string: control character U+000D (CR) must be escaped to \\u000D or \\r"; + return token_type::parse_error; + } + + case 0x0E: + { + error_message = "invalid string: control character U+000E (SO) must be escaped to \\u000E"; + return token_type::parse_error; + } + + case 0x0F: + { + error_message = "invalid string: control character U+000F (SI) must be escaped to \\u000F"; + return token_type::parse_error; + } + + case 0x10: + { + error_message = "invalid string: control character U+0010 (DLE) must be escaped to \\u0010"; + return token_type::parse_error; + } + + case 0x11: + { + error_message = "invalid string: control character U+0011 (DC1) must be escaped to \\u0011"; + return token_type::parse_error; + } + + case 0x12: + { + error_message = "invalid string: control character U+0012 (DC2) must be escaped to \\u0012"; + return token_type::parse_error; + } + + case 0x13: + { + error_message = "invalid string: control character U+0013 (DC3) must be escaped to \\u0013"; + return token_type::parse_error; + } + + case 0x14: + { + error_message = "invalid string: control character U+0014 (DC4) must be escaped to \\u0014"; + return token_type::parse_error; + } + + case 0x15: + { + error_message = "invalid string: control character U+0015 (NAK) must be escaped to \\u0015"; + return token_type::parse_error; + } + + case 0x16: + { + error_message = "invalid string: control character U+0016 (SYN) must be escaped to \\u0016"; + return token_type::parse_error; + } + + case 0x17: + { + error_message = "invalid string: control character U+0017 (ETB) must be escaped to \\u0017"; + return token_type::parse_error; + } + + case 0x18: + { + error_message = "invalid string: control character U+0018 (CAN) must be escaped to \\u0018"; + return token_type::parse_error; + } + + case 0x19: + { + error_message = "invalid string: control character U+0019 (EM) must be escaped to \\u0019"; + return token_type::parse_error; + } + + case 0x1A: + { + error_message = "invalid string: control character U+001A (SUB) must be escaped to \\u001A"; + return token_type::parse_error; + } + + case 0x1B: + { + error_message = "invalid string: control character U+001B (ESC) must be escaped to \\u001B"; + return token_type::parse_error; + } + + case 0x1C: + { + error_message = "invalid string: control character U+001C (FS) must be escaped to \\u001C"; + return token_type::parse_error; + } + + case 0x1D: + { + error_message = "invalid string: control character U+001D (GS) must be escaped to \\u001D"; + return token_type::parse_error; + } + + case 0x1E: + { + error_message = "invalid string: control character U+001E (RS) must be escaped to \\u001E"; + return token_type::parse_error; + } + + case 0x1F: + { + error_message = "invalid string: control character U+001F (US) must be escaped to \\u001F"; + return token_type::parse_error; + } + + // U+0020..U+007F (except U+0022 (quote) and U+005C (backspace)) + case 0x20: + case 0x21: + case 0x23: + case 0x24: + case 0x25: + case 0x26: + case 0x27: + case 0x28: + case 0x29: + case 0x2A: + case 0x2B: + case 0x2C: + case 0x2D: + case 0x2E: + case 0x2F: + case 0x30: + case 0x31: + case 0x32: + case 0x33: + case 0x34: + case 0x35: + case 0x36: + case 0x37: + case 0x38: + case 0x39: + case 0x3A: + case 0x3B: + case 0x3C: + case 0x3D: + case 0x3E: + case 0x3F: + case 0x40: + case 0x41: + case 0x42: + case 0x43: + case 0x44: + case 0x45: + case 0x46: + case 0x47: + case 0x48: + case 0x49: + case 0x4A: + case 0x4B: + case 0x4C: + case 0x4D: + case 0x4E: + case 0x4F: + case 0x50: + case 0x51: + case 0x52: + case 0x53: + case 0x54: + case 0x55: + case 0x56: + case 0x57: + case 0x58: + case 0x59: + case 0x5A: + case 0x5B: + case 0x5D: + case 0x5E: + case 0x5F: + case 0x60: + case 0x61: + case 0x62: + case 0x63: + case 0x64: + case 0x65: + case 0x66: + case 0x67: + case 0x68: + case 0x69: + case 0x6A: + case 0x6B: + case 0x6C: + case 0x6D: + case 0x6E: + case 0x6F: + case 0x70: + case 0x71: + case 0x72: + case 0x73: + case 0x74: + case 0x75: + case 0x76: + case 0x77: + case 0x78: + case 0x79: + case 0x7A: + case 0x7B: + case 0x7C: + case 0x7D: + case 0x7E: + case 0x7F: + { + add(current); + break; + } + + // U+0080..U+07FF: bytes C2..DF 80..BF + case 0xC2: + case 0xC3: + case 0xC4: + case 0xC5: + case 0xC6: + case 0xC7: + case 0xC8: + case 0xC9: + case 0xCA: + case 0xCB: + case 0xCC: + case 0xCD: + case 0xCE: + case 0xCF: + case 0xD0: + case 0xD1: + case 0xD2: + case 0xD3: + case 0xD4: + case 0xD5: + case 0xD6: + case 0xD7: + case 0xD8: + case 0xD9: + case 0xDA: + case 0xDB: + case 0xDC: + case 0xDD: + case 0xDE: + case 0xDF: + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!next_byte_in_range({0x80, 0xBF}))) + { + return token_type::parse_error; + } + break; + } + + // U+0800..U+0FFF: bytes E0 A0..BF 80..BF + case 0xE0: + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!(next_byte_in_range({0xA0, 0xBF, 0x80, 0xBF})))) + { + return token_type::parse_error; + } + break; + } + + // U+1000..U+CFFF: bytes E1..EC 80..BF 80..BF + // U+E000..U+FFFF: bytes EE..EF 80..BF 80..BF + case 0xE1: + case 0xE2: + case 0xE3: + case 0xE4: + case 0xE5: + case 0xE6: + case 0xE7: + case 0xE8: + case 0xE9: + case 0xEA: + case 0xEB: + case 0xEC: + case 0xEE: + case 0xEF: + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!(next_byte_in_range({0x80, 0xBF, 0x80, 0xBF})))) + { + return token_type::parse_error; + } + break; + } + + // U+D000..U+D7FF: bytes ED 80..9F 80..BF + case 0xED: + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!(next_byte_in_range({0x80, 0x9F, 0x80, 0xBF})))) + { + return token_type::parse_error; + } + break; + } + + // U+10000..U+3FFFF F0 90..BF 80..BF 80..BF + case 0xF0: + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!(next_byte_in_range({0x90, 0xBF, 0x80, 0xBF, 0x80, 0xBF})))) + { + return token_type::parse_error; + } + break; + } + + // U+40000..U+FFFFF F1..F3 80..BF 80..BF 80..BF + case 0xF1: + case 0xF2: + case 0xF3: + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!(next_byte_in_range({0x80, 0xBF, 0x80, 0xBF, 0x80, 0xBF})))) + { + return token_type::parse_error; + } + break; + } + + // U+100000..U+10FFFF F4 80..8F 80..BF 80..BF + case 0xF4: + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!(next_byte_in_range({0x80, 0x8F, 0x80, 0xBF, 0x80, 0xBF})))) + { + return token_type::parse_error; + } + break; + } + + // remaining bytes (80..C1 and F5..FF) are ill-formed + default: + { + error_message = "invalid string: ill-formed UTF-8 byte"; + return token_type::parse_error; + } + } + } + } + + /*! + * @brief scan a comment + * @return whether comment could be scanned successfully + */ + bool scan_comment() + { + switch (get()) + { + // single-line comments skip input until a newline or EOF is read + case '/': + { + while (true) + { + switch (get()) + { + case '\n': + case '\r': + case std::char_traits::eof(): + case '\0': + return true; + + default: + break; + } + } + } + + // multi-line comments skip input until */ is read + case '*': + { + while (true) + { + switch (get()) + { + case std::char_traits::eof(): + case '\0': + { + error_message = "invalid comment; missing closing '*/'"; + return false; + } + + case '*': + { + switch (get()) + { + case '/': + return true; + + default: + { + unget(); + continue; + } + } + } + + default: + continue; + } + } + } + + // unexpected character after reading '/' + default: + { + error_message = "invalid comment; expecting '/' or '*' after '/'"; + return false; + } + } + } + + JSON_HEDLEY_NON_NULL(2) + static void strtof(float& f, const char* str, char** endptr) noexcept + { + f = std::strtof(str, endptr); + } + + JSON_HEDLEY_NON_NULL(2) + static void strtof(double& f, const char* str, char** endptr) noexcept + { + f = std::strtod(str, endptr); + } + + JSON_HEDLEY_NON_NULL(2) + static void strtof(long double& f, const char* str, char** endptr) noexcept + { + f = std::strtold(str, endptr); + } + + /*! + @brief scan a number literal + + This function scans a string according to Sect. 6 of RFC 8259. + + The function is realized with a deterministic finite state machine derived + from the grammar described in RFC 8259. Starting in state "init", the + input is read and used to determined the next state. Only state "done" + accepts the number. State "error" is a trap state to model errors. In the + table below, "anything" means any character but the ones listed before. + + state | 0 | 1-9 | e E | + | - | . | anything + ---------|----------|----------|----------|---------|---------|----------|----------- + init | zero | any1 | [error] | [error] | minus | [error] | [error] + minus | zero | any1 | [error] | [error] | [error] | [error] | [error] + zero | done | done | exponent | done | done | decimal1 | done + any1 | any1 | any1 | exponent | done | done | decimal1 | done + decimal1 | decimal2 | decimal2 | [error] | [error] | [error] | [error] | [error] + decimal2 | decimal2 | decimal2 | exponent | done | done | done | done + exponent | any2 | any2 | [error] | sign | sign | [error] | [error] + sign | any2 | any2 | [error] | [error] | [error] | [error] | [error] + any2 | any2 | any2 | done | done | done | done | done + + The state machine is realized with one label per state (prefixed with + "scan_number_") and `goto` statements between them. The state machine + contains cycles, but any cycle can be left when EOF is read. Therefore, + the function is guaranteed to terminate. + + During scanning, the read bytes are stored in token_buffer. This string is + then converted to a signed integer, an unsigned integer, or a + floating-point number. + + @return token_type::value_unsigned, token_type::value_integer, or + token_type::value_float if number could be successfully scanned, + token_type::parse_error otherwise + + @note The scanner is independent of the current locale. Internally, the + locale's decimal point is used instead of `.` to work with the + locale-dependent converters. + */ + token_type scan_number() // lgtm [cpp/use-of-goto] + { + // reset token_buffer to store the number's bytes + reset(); + + // the type of the parsed number; initially set to unsigned; will be + // changed if minus sign, decimal point or exponent is read + token_type number_type = token_type::value_unsigned; + + // state (init): we just found out we need to scan a number + switch (current) + { + case '-': + { + add(current); + goto scan_number_minus; + } + + case '0': + { + add(current); + goto scan_number_zero; + } + + case '1': + case '2': + case '3': + case '4': + case '5': + case '6': + case '7': + case '8': + case '9': + { + add(current); + goto scan_number_any1; + } + + // all other characters are rejected outside scan_number() + default: // LCOV_EXCL_LINE + JSON_ASSERT(false); // NOLINT(cert-dcl03-c,hicpp-static-assert,misc-static-assert) LCOV_EXCL_LINE + } + +scan_number_minus: + // state: we just parsed a leading minus sign + number_type = token_type::value_integer; + switch (get()) + { + case '0': + { + add(current); + goto scan_number_zero; + } + + case '1': + case '2': + case '3': + case '4': + case '5': + case '6': + case '7': + case '8': + case '9': + { + add(current); + goto scan_number_any1; + } + + default: + { + error_message = "invalid number; expected digit after '-'"; + return token_type::parse_error; + } + } + +scan_number_zero: + // state: we just parse a zero (maybe with a leading minus sign) + switch (get()) + { + case '.': + { + add(decimal_point_char); + goto scan_number_decimal1; + } + + case 'e': + case 'E': + { + add(current); + goto scan_number_exponent; + } + + default: + goto scan_number_done; + } + +scan_number_any1: + // state: we just parsed a number 0-9 (maybe with a leading minus sign) + switch (get()) + { + case '0': + case '1': + case '2': + case '3': + case '4': + case '5': + case '6': + case '7': + case '8': + case '9': + { + add(current); + goto scan_number_any1; + } + + case '.': + { + add(decimal_point_char); + goto scan_number_decimal1; + } + + case 'e': + case 'E': + { + add(current); + goto scan_number_exponent; + } + + default: + goto scan_number_done; + } + +scan_number_decimal1: + // state: we just parsed a decimal point + number_type = token_type::value_float; + switch (get()) + { + case '0': + case '1': + case '2': + case '3': + case '4': + case '5': + case '6': + case '7': + case '8': + case '9': + { + add(current); + goto scan_number_decimal2; + } + + default: + { + error_message = "invalid number; expected digit after '.'"; + return token_type::parse_error; + } + } + +scan_number_decimal2: + // we just parsed at least one number after a decimal point + switch (get()) + { + case '0': + case '1': + case '2': + case '3': + case '4': + case '5': + case '6': + case '7': + case '8': + case '9': + { + add(current); + goto scan_number_decimal2; + } + + case 'e': + case 'E': + { + add(current); + goto scan_number_exponent; + } + + default: + goto scan_number_done; + } + +scan_number_exponent: + // we just parsed an exponent + number_type = token_type::value_float; + switch (get()) + { + case '+': + case '-': + { + add(current); + goto scan_number_sign; + } + + case '0': + case '1': + case '2': + case '3': + case '4': + case '5': + case '6': + case '7': + case '8': + case '9': + { + add(current); + goto scan_number_any2; + } + + default: + { + error_message = + "invalid number; expected '+', '-', or digit after exponent"; + return token_type::parse_error; + } + } + +scan_number_sign: + // we just parsed an exponent sign + switch (get()) + { + case '0': + case '1': + case '2': + case '3': + case '4': + case '5': + case '6': + case '7': + case '8': + case '9': + { + add(current); + goto scan_number_any2; + } + + default: + { + error_message = "invalid number; expected digit after exponent sign"; + return token_type::parse_error; + } + } + +scan_number_any2: + // we just parsed a number after the exponent or exponent sign + switch (get()) + { + case '0': + case '1': + case '2': + case '3': + case '4': + case '5': + case '6': + case '7': + case '8': + case '9': + { + add(current); + goto scan_number_any2; + } + + default: + goto scan_number_done; + } + +scan_number_done: + // unget the character after the number (we only read it to know that + // we are done scanning a number) + unget(); + + char* endptr = nullptr; // NOLINT(cppcoreguidelines-pro-type-vararg,hicpp-vararg) + errno = 0; + + // try to parse integers first and fall back to floats + if (number_type == token_type::value_unsigned) + { + const auto x = std::strtoull(token_buffer.data(), &endptr, 10); + + // we checked the number format before + JSON_ASSERT(endptr == token_buffer.data() + token_buffer.size()); + + if (errno == 0) + { + value_unsigned = static_cast(x); + if (value_unsigned == x) + { + return token_type::value_unsigned; + } + } + } + else if (number_type == token_type::value_integer) + { + const auto x = std::strtoll(token_buffer.data(), &endptr, 10); + + // we checked the number format before + JSON_ASSERT(endptr == token_buffer.data() + token_buffer.size()); + + if (errno == 0) + { + value_integer = static_cast(x); + if (value_integer == x) + { + return token_type::value_integer; + } + } + } + + // this code is reached if we parse a floating-point number or if an + // integer conversion above failed + strtof(value_float, token_buffer.data(), &endptr); + + // we checked the number format before + JSON_ASSERT(endptr == token_buffer.data() + token_buffer.size()); + + return token_type::value_float; + } + + /*! + @param[in] literal_text the literal text to expect + @param[in] length the length of the passed literal text + @param[in] return_type the token type to return on success + */ + JSON_HEDLEY_NON_NULL(2) + token_type scan_literal(const char_type* literal_text, const std::size_t length, + token_type return_type) + { + JSON_ASSERT(std::char_traits::to_char_type(current) == literal_text[0]); + for (std::size_t i = 1; i < length; ++i) + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(std::char_traits::to_char_type(get()) != literal_text[i])) + { + error_message = "invalid literal"; + return token_type::parse_error; + } + } + return return_type; + } + + ///////////////////// + // input management + ///////////////////// + + /// reset token_buffer; current character is beginning of token + void reset() noexcept + { + token_buffer.clear(); + token_string.clear(); + token_string.push_back(std::char_traits::to_char_type(current)); + } + + /* + @brief get next character from the input + + This function provides the interface to the used input adapter. It does + not throw in case the input reached EOF, but returns a + `std::char_traits::eof()` in that case. Stores the scanned characters + for use in error messages. + + @return character read from the input + */ + char_int_type get() + { + ++position.chars_read_total; + ++position.chars_read_current_line; + + if (next_unget) + { + // just reset the next_unget variable and work with current + next_unget = false; + } + else + { + current = ia.get_character(); + } + + if (JSON_HEDLEY_LIKELY(current != std::char_traits::eof())) + { + token_string.push_back(std::char_traits::to_char_type(current)); + } + + if (current == '\n') + { + ++position.lines_read; + position.chars_read_current_line = 0; + } + + return current; + } + + /*! + @brief unget current character (read it again on next get) + + We implement unget by setting variable next_unget to true. The input is not + changed - we just simulate ungetting by modifying chars_read_total, + chars_read_current_line, and token_string. The next call to get() will + behave as if the unget character is read again. + */ + void unget() + { + next_unget = true; + + --position.chars_read_total; + + // in case we "unget" a newline, we have to also decrement the lines_read + if (position.chars_read_current_line == 0) + { + if (position.lines_read > 0) + { + --position.lines_read; + } + } + else + { + --position.chars_read_current_line; + } + + if (JSON_HEDLEY_LIKELY(current != std::char_traits::eof())) + { + JSON_ASSERT(!token_string.empty()); + token_string.pop_back(); + } + } + + /// add a character to token_buffer + void add(char_int_type c) + { + token_buffer.push_back(static_cast(c)); + } + + public: + ///////////////////// + // value getters + ///////////////////// + + /// return integer value + constexpr number_integer_t get_number_integer() const noexcept + { + return value_integer; + } + + /// return unsigned integer value + constexpr number_unsigned_t get_number_unsigned() const noexcept + { + return value_unsigned; + } + + /// return floating-point value + constexpr number_float_t get_number_float() const noexcept + { + return value_float; + } + + /// return current string value (implicitly resets the token; useful only once) + string_t& get_string() + { + return token_buffer; + } + + ///////////////////// + // diagnostics + ///////////////////// + + /// return position of last read token + constexpr position_t get_position() const noexcept + { + return position; + } + + /// return the last read token (for errors only). Will never contain EOF + /// (an arbitrary value that is not a valid char value, often -1), because + /// 255 may legitimately occur. May contain NUL, which should be escaped. + std::string get_token_string() const + { + // escape control characters + std::string result; + for (const auto c : token_string) + { + if (static_cast(c) <= '\x1F') + { + // escape control characters + std::array cs{{}}; + static_cast((std::snprintf)(cs.data(), cs.size(), "", static_cast(c))); // NOLINT(cppcoreguidelines-pro-type-vararg,hicpp-vararg) + result += cs.data(); + } + else + { + // add character as is + result.push_back(static_cast(c)); + } + } + + return result; + } + + /// return syntax error message + JSON_HEDLEY_RETURNS_NON_NULL + constexpr const char* get_error_message() const noexcept + { + return error_message; + } + + ///////////////////// + // actual scanner + ///////////////////// + + /*! + @brief skip the UTF-8 byte order mark + @return true iff there is no BOM or the correct BOM has been skipped + */ + bool skip_bom() + { + if (get() == 0xEF) + { + // check if we completely parse the BOM + return get() == 0xBB && get() == 0xBF; + } + + // the first character is not the beginning of the BOM; unget it to + // process is later + unget(); + return true; + } + + void skip_whitespace() + { + do + { + get(); + } + while (current == ' ' || current == '\t' || current == '\n' || current == '\r'); + } + + token_type scan() + { + // initially, skip the BOM + if (position.chars_read_total == 0 && !skip_bom()) + { + error_message = "invalid BOM; must be 0xEF 0xBB 0xBF if given"; + return token_type::parse_error; + } + + // read next character and ignore whitespace + skip_whitespace(); + + // ignore comments + while (ignore_comments && current == '/') + { + if (!scan_comment()) + { + return token_type::parse_error; + } + + // skip following whitespace + skip_whitespace(); + } + + switch (current) + { + // structural characters + case '[': + return token_type::begin_array; + case ']': + return token_type::end_array; + case '{': + return token_type::begin_object; + case '}': + return token_type::end_object; + case ':': + return token_type::name_separator; + case ',': + return token_type::value_separator; + + // literals + case 't': + { + std::array true_literal = {{static_cast('t'), static_cast('r'), static_cast('u'), static_cast('e')}}; + return scan_literal(true_literal.data(), true_literal.size(), token_type::literal_true); + } + case 'f': + { + std::array false_literal = {{static_cast('f'), static_cast('a'), static_cast('l'), static_cast('s'), static_cast('e')}}; + return scan_literal(false_literal.data(), false_literal.size(), token_type::literal_false); + } + case 'n': + { + std::array null_literal = {{static_cast('n'), static_cast('u'), static_cast('l'), static_cast('l')}}; + return scan_literal(null_literal.data(), null_literal.size(), token_type::literal_null); + } + + // string + case '\"': + return scan_string(); + + // number + case '-': + case '0': + case '1': + case '2': + case '3': + case '4': + case '5': + case '6': + case '7': + case '8': + case '9': + return scan_number(); + + // end of input (the null byte is needed when parsing from + // string literals) + case '\0': + case std::char_traits::eof(): + return token_type::end_of_input; + + // error + default: + error_message = "invalid literal"; + return token_type::parse_error; + } + } + + private: + /// input adapter + InputAdapterType ia; + + /// whether comments should be ignored (true) or signaled as errors (false) + const bool ignore_comments = false; + + /// the current character + char_int_type current = std::char_traits::eof(); + + /// whether the next get() call should just return current + bool next_unget = false; + + /// the start position of the current token + position_t position {}; + + /// raw input token string (for error messages) + std::vector token_string {}; + + /// buffer for variable-length tokens (numbers, strings) + string_t token_buffer {}; + + /// a description of occurred lexer errors + const char* error_message = ""; + + // number values + number_integer_t value_integer = 0; + number_unsigned_t value_unsigned = 0; + number_float_t value_float = 0; + + /// the decimal point + const char_int_type decimal_point_char = '.'; +}; +} // namespace detail +} // namespace nlohmann + +// #include + +// #include + + +#include // size_t +#include // declval +#include // string + +// #include + +// #include + + +namespace nlohmann +{ +namespace detail +{ +template +using null_function_t = decltype(std::declval().null()); + +template +using boolean_function_t = + decltype(std::declval().boolean(std::declval())); + +template +using number_integer_function_t = + decltype(std::declval().number_integer(std::declval())); + +template +using number_unsigned_function_t = + decltype(std::declval().number_unsigned(std::declval())); + +template +using number_float_function_t = decltype(std::declval().number_float( + std::declval(), std::declval())); + +template +using string_function_t = + decltype(std::declval().string(std::declval())); + +template +using binary_function_t = + decltype(std::declval().binary(std::declval())); + +template +using start_object_function_t = + decltype(std::declval().start_object(std::declval())); + +template +using key_function_t = + decltype(std::declval().key(std::declval())); + +template +using end_object_function_t = decltype(std::declval().end_object()); + +template +using start_array_function_t = + decltype(std::declval().start_array(std::declval())); + +template +using end_array_function_t = decltype(std::declval().end_array()); + +template +using parse_error_function_t = decltype(std::declval().parse_error( + std::declval(), std::declval(), + std::declval())); + +template +struct is_sax +{ + private: + static_assert(is_basic_json::value, + "BasicJsonType must be of type basic_json<...>"); + + using number_integer_t = typename BasicJsonType::number_integer_t; + using number_unsigned_t = typename BasicJsonType::number_unsigned_t; + using number_float_t = typename BasicJsonType::number_float_t; + using string_t = typename BasicJsonType::string_t; + using binary_t = typename BasicJsonType::binary_t; + using exception_t = typename BasicJsonType::exception; + + public: + static constexpr bool value = + is_detected_exact::value && + is_detected_exact::value && + is_detected_exact::value && + is_detected_exact::value && + is_detected_exact::value && + is_detected_exact::value && + is_detected_exact::value && + is_detected_exact::value && + is_detected_exact::value && + is_detected_exact::value && + is_detected_exact::value && + is_detected_exact::value && + is_detected_exact::value; +}; + +template +struct is_sax_static_asserts +{ + private: + static_assert(is_basic_json::value, + "BasicJsonType must be of type basic_json<...>"); + + using number_integer_t = typename BasicJsonType::number_integer_t; + using number_unsigned_t = typename BasicJsonType::number_unsigned_t; + using number_float_t = typename BasicJsonType::number_float_t; + using string_t = typename BasicJsonType::string_t; + using binary_t = typename BasicJsonType::binary_t; + using exception_t = typename BasicJsonType::exception; + + public: + static_assert(is_detected_exact::value, + "Missing/invalid function: bool null()"); + static_assert(is_detected_exact::value, + "Missing/invalid function: bool boolean(bool)"); + static_assert(is_detected_exact::value, + "Missing/invalid function: bool boolean(bool)"); + static_assert( + is_detected_exact::value, + "Missing/invalid function: bool number_integer(number_integer_t)"); + static_assert( + is_detected_exact::value, + "Missing/invalid function: bool number_unsigned(number_unsigned_t)"); + static_assert(is_detected_exact::value, + "Missing/invalid function: bool number_float(number_float_t, const string_t&)"); + static_assert( + is_detected_exact::value, + "Missing/invalid function: bool string(string_t&)"); + static_assert( + is_detected_exact::value, + "Missing/invalid function: bool binary(binary_t&)"); + static_assert(is_detected_exact::value, + "Missing/invalid function: bool start_object(std::size_t)"); + static_assert(is_detected_exact::value, + "Missing/invalid function: bool key(string_t&)"); + static_assert(is_detected_exact::value, + "Missing/invalid function: bool end_object()"); + static_assert(is_detected_exact::value, + "Missing/invalid function: bool start_array(std::size_t)"); + static_assert(is_detected_exact::value, + "Missing/invalid function: bool end_array()"); + static_assert( + is_detected_exact::value, + "Missing/invalid function: bool parse_error(std::size_t, const " + "std::string&, const exception&)"); +}; +} // namespace detail +} // namespace nlohmann + +// #include + +// #include + + +namespace nlohmann +{ +namespace detail +{ + +/// how to treat CBOR tags +enum class cbor_tag_handler_t +{ + error, ///< throw a parse_error exception in case of a tag + ignore, ///< ignore tags + store ///< store tags as binary type +}; + +/*! +@brief determine system byte order + +@return true if and only if system's byte order is little endian + +@note from https://stackoverflow.com/a/1001328/266378 +*/ +static inline bool little_endianness(int num = 1) noexcept +{ + return *reinterpret_cast(&num) == 1; +} + + +/////////////////// +// binary reader // +/////////////////// + +/*! +@brief deserialization of CBOR, MessagePack, and UBJSON values +*/ +template> +class binary_reader +{ + using number_integer_t = typename BasicJsonType::number_integer_t; + using number_unsigned_t = typename BasicJsonType::number_unsigned_t; + using number_float_t = typename BasicJsonType::number_float_t; + using string_t = typename BasicJsonType::string_t; + using binary_t = typename BasicJsonType::binary_t; + using json_sax_t = SAX; + using char_type = typename InputAdapterType::char_type; + using char_int_type = typename std::char_traits::int_type; + + public: + /*! + @brief create a binary reader + + @param[in] adapter input adapter to read from + */ + explicit binary_reader(InputAdapterType&& adapter) noexcept : ia(std::move(adapter)) + { + (void)detail::is_sax_static_asserts {}; + } + + // make class move-only + binary_reader(const binary_reader&) = delete; + binary_reader(binary_reader&&) = default; // NOLINT(hicpp-noexcept-move,performance-noexcept-move-constructor) + binary_reader& operator=(const binary_reader&) = delete; + binary_reader& operator=(binary_reader&&) = default; // NOLINT(hicpp-noexcept-move,performance-noexcept-move-constructor) + ~binary_reader() = default; + + /*! + @param[in] format the binary format to parse + @param[in] sax_ a SAX event processor + @param[in] strict whether to expect the input to be consumed completed + @param[in] tag_handler how to treat CBOR tags + + @return whether parsing was successful + */ + JSON_HEDLEY_NON_NULL(3) + bool sax_parse(const input_format_t format, + json_sax_t* sax_, + const bool strict = true, + const cbor_tag_handler_t tag_handler = cbor_tag_handler_t::error) + { + sax = sax_; + bool result = false; + + switch (format) + { + case input_format_t::bson: + result = parse_bson_internal(); + break; + + case input_format_t::cbor: + result = parse_cbor_internal(true, tag_handler); + break; + + case input_format_t::msgpack: + result = parse_msgpack_internal(); + break; + + case input_format_t::ubjson: + result = parse_ubjson_internal(); + break; + + case input_format_t::json: // LCOV_EXCL_LINE + default: // LCOV_EXCL_LINE + JSON_ASSERT(false); // NOLINT(cert-dcl03-c,hicpp-static-assert,misc-static-assert) LCOV_EXCL_LINE + } + + // strict mode: next byte must be EOF + if (result && strict) + { + if (format == input_format_t::ubjson) + { + get_ignore_noop(); + } + else + { + get(); + } + + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(current != std::char_traits::eof())) + { + return sax->parse_error(chars_read, get_token_string(), + parse_error::create(110, chars_read, exception_message(format, "expected end of input; last byte: 0x" + get_token_string(), "value"), BasicJsonType())); + } + } + + return result; + } + + private: + ////////// + // BSON // + ////////// + + /*! + @brief Reads in a BSON-object and passes it to the SAX-parser. + @return whether a valid BSON-value was passed to the SAX parser + */ + bool parse_bson_internal() + { + std::int32_t document_size{}; + get_number(input_format_t::bson, document_size); + + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!sax->start_object(static_cast(-1)))) + { + return false; + } + + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!parse_bson_element_list(/*is_array*/false))) + { + return false; + } + + return sax->end_object(); + } + + /*! + @brief Parses a C-style string from the BSON input. + @param[in,out] result A reference to the string variable where the read + string is to be stored. + @return `true` if the \x00-byte indicating the end of the string was + encountered before the EOF; false` indicates an unexpected EOF. + */ + bool get_bson_cstr(string_t& result) + { + auto out = std::back_inserter(result); + while (true) + { + get(); + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!unexpect_eof(input_format_t::bson, "cstring"))) + { + return false; + } + if (current == 0x00) + { + return true; + } + *out++ = static_cast(current); + } + } + + /*! + @brief Parses a zero-terminated string of length @a len from the BSON + input. + @param[in] len The length (including the zero-byte at the end) of the + string to be read. + @param[in,out] result A reference to the string variable where the read + string is to be stored. + @tparam NumberType The type of the length @a len + @pre len >= 1 + @return `true` if the string was successfully parsed + */ + template + bool get_bson_string(const NumberType len, string_t& result) + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(len < 1)) + { + auto last_token = get_token_string(); + return sax->parse_error(chars_read, last_token, parse_error::create(112, chars_read, exception_message(input_format_t::bson, "string length must be at least 1, is " + std::to_string(len), "string"), BasicJsonType())); + } + + return get_string(input_format_t::bson, len - static_cast(1), result) && get() != std::char_traits::eof(); + } + + /*! + @brief Parses a byte array input of length @a len from the BSON input. + @param[in] len The length of the byte array to be read. + @param[in,out] result A reference to the binary variable where the read + array is to be stored. + @tparam NumberType The type of the length @a len + @pre len >= 0 + @return `true` if the byte array was successfully parsed + */ + template + bool get_bson_binary(const NumberType len, binary_t& result) + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(len < 0)) + { + auto last_token = get_token_string(); + return sax->parse_error(chars_read, last_token, parse_error::create(112, chars_read, exception_message(input_format_t::bson, "byte array length cannot be negative, is " + std::to_string(len), "binary"), BasicJsonType())); + } + + // All BSON binary values have a subtype + std::uint8_t subtype{}; + get_number(input_format_t::bson, subtype); + result.set_subtype(subtype); + + return get_binary(input_format_t::bson, len, result); + } + + /*! + @brief Read a BSON document element of the given @a element_type. + @param[in] element_type The BSON element type, c.f. http://bsonspec.org/spec.html + @param[in] element_type_parse_position The position in the input stream, + where the `element_type` was read. + @warning Not all BSON element types are supported yet. An unsupported + @a element_type will give rise to a parse_error.114: + Unsupported BSON record type 0x... + @return whether a valid BSON-object/array was passed to the SAX parser + */ + bool parse_bson_element_internal(const char_int_type element_type, + const std::size_t element_type_parse_position) + { + switch (element_type) + { + case 0x01: // double + { + double number{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::bson, number) && sax->number_float(static_cast(number), ""); + } + + case 0x02: // string + { + std::int32_t len{}; + string_t value; + return get_number(input_format_t::bson, len) && get_bson_string(len, value) && sax->string(value); + } + + case 0x03: // object + { + return parse_bson_internal(); + } + + case 0x04: // array + { + return parse_bson_array(); + } + + case 0x05: // binary + { + std::int32_t len{}; + binary_t value; + return get_number(input_format_t::bson, len) && get_bson_binary(len, value) && sax->binary(value); + } + + case 0x08: // boolean + { + return sax->boolean(get() != 0); + } + + case 0x0A: // null + { + return sax->null(); + } + + case 0x10: // int32 + { + std::int32_t value{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::bson, value) && sax->number_integer(value); + } + + case 0x12: // int64 + { + std::int64_t value{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::bson, value) && sax->number_integer(value); + } + + default: // anything else not supported (yet) + { + std::array cr{{}}; + static_cast((std::snprintf)(cr.data(), cr.size(), "%.2hhX", static_cast(element_type))); // NOLINT(cppcoreguidelines-pro-type-vararg,hicpp-vararg) + return sax->parse_error(element_type_parse_position, std::string(cr.data()), parse_error::create(114, element_type_parse_position, "Unsupported BSON record type 0x" + std::string(cr.data()), BasicJsonType())); + } + } + } + + /*! + @brief Read a BSON element list (as specified in the BSON-spec) + + The same binary layout is used for objects and arrays, hence it must be + indicated with the argument @a is_array which one is expected + (true --> array, false --> object). + + @param[in] is_array Determines if the element list being read is to be + treated as an object (@a is_array == false), or as an + array (@a is_array == true). + @return whether a valid BSON-object/array was passed to the SAX parser + */ + bool parse_bson_element_list(const bool is_array) + { + string_t key; + + while (auto element_type = get()) + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!unexpect_eof(input_format_t::bson, "element list"))) + { + return false; + } + + const std::size_t element_type_parse_position = chars_read; + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!get_bson_cstr(key))) + { + return false; + } + + if (!is_array && !sax->key(key)) + { + return false; + } + + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!parse_bson_element_internal(element_type, element_type_parse_position))) + { + return false; + } + + // get_bson_cstr only appends + key.clear(); + } + + return true; + } + + /*! + @brief Reads an array from the BSON input and passes it to the SAX-parser. + @return whether a valid BSON-array was passed to the SAX parser + */ + bool parse_bson_array() + { + std::int32_t document_size{}; + get_number(input_format_t::bson, document_size); + + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!sax->start_array(static_cast(-1)))) + { + return false; + } + + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!parse_bson_element_list(/*is_array*/true))) + { + return false; + } + + return sax->end_array(); + } + + ////////// + // CBOR // + ////////// + + /*! + @param[in] get_char whether a new character should be retrieved from the + input (true) or whether the last read character should + be considered instead (false) + @param[in] tag_handler how CBOR tags should be treated + + @return whether a valid CBOR value was passed to the SAX parser + */ + bool parse_cbor_internal(const bool get_char, + const cbor_tag_handler_t tag_handler) + { + switch (get_char ? get() : current) + { + // EOF + case std::char_traits::eof(): + return unexpect_eof(input_format_t::cbor, "value"); + + // Integer 0x00..0x17 (0..23) + case 0x00: + case 0x01: + case 0x02: + case 0x03: + case 0x04: + case 0x05: + case 0x06: + case 0x07: + case 0x08: + case 0x09: + case 0x0A: + case 0x0B: + case 0x0C: + case 0x0D: + case 0x0E: + case 0x0F: + case 0x10: + case 0x11: + case 0x12: + case 0x13: + case 0x14: + case 0x15: + case 0x16: + case 0x17: + return sax->number_unsigned(static_cast(current)); + + case 0x18: // Unsigned integer (one-byte uint8_t follows) + { + std::uint8_t number{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::cbor, number) && sax->number_unsigned(number); + } + + case 0x19: // Unsigned integer (two-byte uint16_t follows) + { + std::uint16_t number{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::cbor, number) && sax->number_unsigned(number); + } + + case 0x1A: // Unsigned integer (four-byte uint32_t follows) + { + std::uint32_t number{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::cbor, number) && sax->number_unsigned(number); + } + + case 0x1B: // Unsigned integer (eight-byte uint64_t follows) + { + std::uint64_t number{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::cbor, number) && sax->number_unsigned(number); + } + + // Negative integer -1-0x00..-1-0x17 (-1..-24) + case 0x20: + case 0x21: + case 0x22: + case 0x23: + case 0x24: + case 0x25: + case 0x26: + case 0x27: + case 0x28: + case 0x29: + case 0x2A: + case 0x2B: + case 0x2C: + case 0x2D: + case 0x2E: + case 0x2F: + case 0x30: + case 0x31: + case 0x32: + case 0x33: + case 0x34: + case 0x35: + case 0x36: + case 0x37: + return sax->number_integer(static_cast(0x20 - 1 - current)); + + case 0x38: // Negative integer (one-byte uint8_t follows) + { + std::uint8_t number{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::cbor, number) && sax->number_integer(static_cast(-1) - number); + } + + case 0x39: // Negative integer -1-n (two-byte uint16_t follows) + { + std::uint16_t number{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::cbor, number) && sax->number_integer(static_cast(-1) - number); + } + + case 0x3A: // Negative integer -1-n (four-byte uint32_t follows) + { + std::uint32_t number{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::cbor, number) && sax->number_integer(static_cast(-1) - number); + } + + case 0x3B: // Negative integer -1-n (eight-byte uint64_t follows) + { + std::uint64_t number{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::cbor, number) && sax->number_integer(static_cast(-1) + - static_cast(number)); + } + + // Binary data (0x00..0x17 bytes follow) + case 0x40: + case 0x41: + case 0x42: + case 0x43: + case 0x44: + case 0x45: + case 0x46: + case 0x47: + case 0x48: + case 0x49: + case 0x4A: + case 0x4B: + case 0x4C: + case 0x4D: + case 0x4E: + case 0x4F: + case 0x50: + case 0x51: + case 0x52: + case 0x53: + case 0x54: + case 0x55: + case 0x56: + case 0x57: + case 0x58: // Binary data (one-byte uint8_t for n follows) + case 0x59: // Binary data (two-byte uint16_t for n follow) + case 0x5A: // Binary data (four-byte uint32_t for n follow) + case 0x5B: // Binary data (eight-byte uint64_t for n follow) + case 0x5F: // Binary data (indefinite length) + { + binary_t b; + return get_cbor_binary(b) && sax->binary(b); + } + + // UTF-8 string (0x00..0x17 bytes follow) + case 0x60: + case 0x61: + case 0x62: + case 0x63: + case 0x64: + case 0x65: + case 0x66: + case 0x67: + case 0x68: + case 0x69: + case 0x6A: + case 0x6B: + case 0x6C: + case 0x6D: + case 0x6E: + case 0x6F: + case 0x70: + case 0x71: + case 0x72: + case 0x73: + case 0x74: + case 0x75: + case 0x76: + case 0x77: + case 0x78: // UTF-8 string (one-byte uint8_t for n follows) + case 0x79: // UTF-8 string (two-byte uint16_t for n follow) + case 0x7A: // UTF-8 string (four-byte uint32_t for n follow) + case 0x7B: // UTF-8 string (eight-byte uint64_t for n follow) + case 0x7F: // UTF-8 string (indefinite length) + { + string_t s; + return get_cbor_string(s) && sax->string(s); + } + + // array (0x00..0x17 data items follow) + case 0x80: + case 0x81: + case 0x82: + case 0x83: + case 0x84: + case 0x85: + case 0x86: + case 0x87: + case 0x88: + case 0x89: + case 0x8A: + case 0x8B: + case 0x8C: + case 0x8D: + case 0x8E: + case 0x8F: + case 0x90: + case 0x91: + case 0x92: + case 0x93: + case 0x94: + case 0x95: + case 0x96: + case 0x97: + return get_cbor_array(static_cast(static_cast(current) & 0x1Fu), tag_handler); + + case 0x98: // array (one-byte uint8_t for n follows) + { + std::uint8_t len{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::cbor, len) && get_cbor_array(static_cast(len), tag_handler); + } + + case 0x99: // array (two-byte uint16_t for n follow) + { + std::uint16_t len{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::cbor, len) && get_cbor_array(static_cast(len), tag_handler); + } + + case 0x9A: // array (four-byte uint32_t for n follow) + { + std::uint32_t len{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::cbor, len) && get_cbor_array(static_cast(len), tag_handler); + } + + case 0x9B: // array (eight-byte uint64_t for n follow) + { + std::uint64_t len{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::cbor, len) && get_cbor_array(detail::conditional_static_cast(len), tag_handler); + } + + case 0x9F: // array (indefinite length) + return get_cbor_array(static_cast(-1), tag_handler); + + // map (0x00..0x17 pairs of data items follow) + case 0xA0: + case 0xA1: + case 0xA2: + case 0xA3: + case 0xA4: + case 0xA5: + case 0xA6: + case 0xA7: + case 0xA8: + case 0xA9: + case 0xAA: + case 0xAB: + case 0xAC: + case 0xAD: + case 0xAE: + case 0xAF: + case 0xB0: + case 0xB1: + case 0xB2: + case 0xB3: + case 0xB4: + case 0xB5: + case 0xB6: + case 0xB7: + return get_cbor_object(static_cast(static_cast(current) & 0x1Fu), tag_handler); + + case 0xB8: // map (one-byte uint8_t for n follows) + { + std::uint8_t len{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::cbor, len) && get_cbor_object(static_cast(len), tag_handler); + } + + case 0xB9: // map (two-byte uint16_t for n follow) + { + std::uint16_t len{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::cbor, len) && get_cbor_object(static_cast(len), tag_handler); + } + + case 0xBA: // map (four-byte uint32_t for n follow) + { + std::uint32_t len{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::cbor, len) && get_cbor_object(static_cast(len), tag_handler); + } + + case 0xBB: // map (eight-byte uint64_t for n follow) + { + std::uint64_t len{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::cbor, len) && get_cbor_object(detail::conditional_static_cast(len), tag_handler); + } + + case 0xBF: // map (indefinite length) + return get_cbor_object(static_cast(-1), tag_handler); + + case 0xC6: // tagged item + case 0xC7: + case 0xC8: + case 0xC9: + case 0xCA: + case 0xCB: + case 0xCC: + case 0xCD: + case 0xCE: + case 0xCF: + case 0xD0: + case 0xD1: + case 0xD2: + case 0xD3: + case 0xD4: + case 0xD8: // tagged item (1 bytes follow) + case 0xD9: // tagged item (2 bytes follow) + case 0xDA: // tagged item (4 bytes follow) + case 0xDB: // tagged item (8 bytes follow) + { + switch (tag_handler) + { + case cbor_tag_handler_t::error: + { + auto last_token = get_token_string(); + return sax->parse_error(chars_read, last_token, parse_error::create(112, chars_read, exception_message(input_format_t::cbor, "invalid byte: 0x" + last_token, "value"), BasicJsonType())); + } + + case cbor_tag_handler_t::ignore: + { + // ignore binary subtype + switch (current) + { + case 0xD8: + { + std::uint8_t subtype_to_ignore{}; + get_number(input_format_t::cbor, subtype_to_ignore); + break; + } + case 0xD9: + { + std::uint16_t subtype_to_ignore{}; + get_number(input_format_t::cbor, subtype_to_ignore); + break; + } + case 0xDA: + { + std::uint32_t subtype_to_ignore{}; + get_number(input_format_t::cbor, subtype_to_ignore); + break; + } + case 0xDB: + { + std::uint64_t subtype_to_ignore{}; + get_number(input_format_t::cbor, subtype_to_ignore); + break; + } + default: + break; + } + return parse_cbor_internal(true, tag_handler); + } + + case cbor_tag_handler_t::store: + { + binary_t b; + // use binary subtype and store in binary container + switch (current) + { + case 0xD8: + { + std::uint8_t subtype{}; + get_number(input_format_t::cbor, subtype); + b.set_subtype(detail::conditional_static_cast(subtype)); + break; + } + case 0xD9: + { + std::uint16_t subtype{}; + get_number(input_format_t::cbor, subtype); + b.set_subtype(detail::conditional_static_cast(subtype)); + break; + } + case 0xDA: + { + std::uint32_t subtype{}; + get_number(input_format_t::cbor, subtype); + b.set_subtype(detail::conditional_static_cast(subtype)); + break; + } + case 0xDB: + { + std::uint64_t subtype{}; + get_number(input_format_t::cbor, subtype); + b.set_subtype(detail::conditional_static_cast(subtype)); + break; + } + default: + return parse_cbor_internal(true, tag_handler); + } + get(); + return get_cbor_binary(b) && sax->binary(b); + } + + default: // LCOV_EXCL_LINE + JSON_ASSERT(false); // NOLINT(cert-dcl03-c,hicpp-static-assert,misc-static-assert) LCOV_EXCL_LINE + return false; // LCOV_EXCL_LINE + } + } + + case 0xF4: // false + return sax->boolean(false); + + case 0xF5: // true + return sax->boolean(true); + + case 0xF6: // null + return sax->null(); + + case 0xF9: // Half-Precision Float (two-byte IEEE 754) + { + const auto byte1_raw = get(); + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!unexpect_eof(input_format_t::cbor, "number"))) + { + return false; + } + const auto byte2_raw = get(); + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!unexpect_eof(input_format_t::cbor, "number"))) + { + return false; + } + + const auto byte1 = static_cast(byte1_raw); + const auto byte2 = static_cast(byte2_raw); + + // code from RFC 7049, Appendix D, Figure 3: + // As half-precision floating-point numbers were only added + // to IEEE 754 in 2008, today's programming platforms often + // still only have limited support for them. It is very + // easy to include at least decoding support for them even + // without such support. An example of a small decoder for + // half-precision floating-point numbers in the C language + // is shown in Fig. 3. + const auto half = static_cast((byte1 << 8u) + byte2); + const double val = [&half] + { + const int exp = (half >> 10u) & 0x1Fu; + const unsigned int mant = half & 0x3FFu; + JSON_ASSERT(0 <= exp&& exp <= 32); + JSON_ASSERT(mant <= 1024); + switch (exp) + { + case 0: + return std::ldexp(mant, -24); + case 31: + return (mant == 0) + ? std::numeric_limits::infinity() + : std::numeric_limits::quiet_NaN(); + default: + return std::ldexp(mant + 1024, exp - 25); + } + }(); + return sax->number_float((half & 0x8000u) != 0 + ? static_cast(-val) + : static_cast(val), ""); + } + + case 0xFA: // Single-Precision Float (four-byte IEEE 754) + { + float number{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::cbor, number) && sax->number_float(static_cast(number), ""); + } + + case 0xFB: // Double-Precision Float (eight-byte IEEE 754) + { + double number{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::cbor, number) && sax->number_float(static_cast(number), ""); + } + + default: // anything else (0xFF is handled inside the other types) + { + auto last_token = get_token_string(); + return sax->parse_error(chars_read, last_token, parse_error::create(112, chars_read, exception_message(input_format_t::cbor, "invalid byte: 0x" + last_token, "value"), BasicJsonType())); + } + } + } + + /*! + @brief reads a CBOR string + + This function first reads starting bytes to determine the expected + string length and then copies this number of bytes into a string. + Additionally, CBOR's strings with indefinite lengths are supported. + + @param[out] result created string + + @return whether string creation completed + */ + bool get_cbor_string(string_t& result) + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!unexpect_eof(input_format_t::cbor, "string"))) + { + return false; + } + + switch (current) + { + // UTF-8 string (0x00..0x17 bytes follow) + case 0x60: + case 0x61: + case 0x62: + case 0x63: + case 0x64: + case 0x65: + case 0x66: + case 0x67: + case 0x68: + case 0x69: + case 0x6A: + case 0x6B: + case 0x6C: + case 0x6D: + case 0x6E: + case 0x6F: + case 0x70: + case 0x71: + case 0x72: + case 0x73: + case 0x74: + case 0x75: + case 0x76: + case 0x77: + { + return get_string(input_format_t::cbor, static_cast(current) & 0x1Fu, result); + } + + case 0x78: // UTF-8 string (one-byte uint8_t for n follows) + { + std::uint8_t len{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::cbor, len) && get_string(input_format_t::cbor, len, result); + } + + case 0x79: // UTF-8 string (two-byte uint16_t for n follow) + { + std::uint16_t len{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::cbor, len) && get_string(input_format_t::cbor, len, result); + } + + case 0x7A: // UTF-8 string (four-byte uint32_t for n follow) + { + std::uint32_t len{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::cbor, len) && get_string(input_format_t::cbor, len, result); + } + + case 0x7B: // UTF-8 string (eight-byte uint64_t for n follow) + { + std::uint64_t len{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::cbor, len) && get_string(input_format_t::cbor, len, result); + } + + case 0x7F: // UTF-8 string (indefinite length) + { + while (get() != 0xFF) + { + string_t chunk; + if (!get_cbor_string(chunk)) + { + return false; + } + result.append(chunk); + } + return true; + } + + default: + { + auto last_token = get_token_string(); + return sax->parse_error(chars_read, last_token, parse_error::create(113, chars_read, exception_message(input_format_t::cbor, "expected length specification (0x60-0x7B) or indefinite string type (0x7F); last byte: 0x" + last_token, "string"), BasicJsonType())); + } + } + } + + /*! + @brief reads a CBOR byte array + + This function first reads starting bytes to determine the expected + byte array length and then copies this number of bytes into the byte array. + Additionally, CBOR's byte arrays with indefinite lengths are supported. + + @param[out] result created byte array + + @return whether byte array creation completed + */ + bool get_cbor_binary(binary_t& result) + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!unexpect_eof(input_format_t::cbor, "binary"))) + { + return false; + } + + switch (current) + { + // Binary data (0x00..0x17 bytes follow) + case 0x40: + case 0x41: + case 0x42: + case 0x43: + case 0x44: + case 0x45: + case 0x46: + case 0x47: + case 0x48: + case 0x49: + case 0x4A: + case 0x4B: + case 0x4C: + case 0x4D: + case 0x4E: + case 0x4F: + case 0x50: + case 0x51: + case 0x52: + case 0x53: + case 0x54: + case 0x55: + case 0x56: + case 0x57: + { + return get_binary(input_format_t::cbor, static_cast(current) & 0x1Fu, result); + } + + case 0x58: // Binary data (one-byte uint8_t for n follows) + { + std::uint8_t len{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::cbor, len) && + get_binary(input_format_t::cbor, len, result); + } + + case 0x59: // Binary data (two-byte uint16_t for n follow) + { + std::uint16_t len{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::cbor, len) && + get_binary(input_format_t::cbor, len, result); + } + + case 0x5A: // Binary data (four-byte uint32_t for n follow) + { + std::uint32_t len{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::cbor, len) && + get_binary(input_format_t::cbor, len, result); + } + + case 0x5B: // Binary data (eight-byte uint64_t for n follow) + { + std::uint64_t len{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::cbor, len) && + get_binary(input_format_t::cbor, len, result); + } + + case 0x5F: // Binary data (indefinite length) + { + while (get() != 0xFF) + { + binary_t chunk; + if (!get_cbor_binary(chunk)) + { + return false; + } + result.insert(result.end(), chunk.begin(), chunk.end()); + } + return true; + } + + default: + { + auto last_token = get_token_string(); + return sax->parse_error(chars_read, last_token, parse_error::create(113, chars_read, exception_message(input_format_t::cbor, "expected length specification (0x40-0x5B) or indefinite binary array type (0x5F); last byte: 0x" + last_token, "binary"), BasicJsonType())); + } + } + } + + /*! + @param[in] len the length of the array or static_cast(-1) for an + array of indefinite size + @param[in] tag_handler how CBOR tags should be treated + @return whether array creation completed + */ + bool get_cbor_array(const std::size_t len, + const cbor_tag_handler_t tag_handler) + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!sax->start_array(len))) + { + return false; + } + + if (len != static_cast(-1)) + { + for (std::size_t i = 0; i < len; ++i) + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!parse_cbor_internal(true, tag_handler))) + { + return false; + } + } + } + else + { + while (get() != 0xFF) + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!parse_cbor_internal(false, tag_handler))) + { + return false; + } + } + } + + return sax->end_array(); + } + + /*! + @param[in] len the length of the object or static_cast(-1) for an + object of indefinite size + @param[in] tag_handler how CBOR tags should be treated + @return whether object creation completed + */ + bool get_cbor_object(const std::size_t len, + const cbor_tag_handler_t tag_handler) + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!sax->start_object(len))) + { + return false; + } + + if (len != 0) + { + string_t key; + if (len != static_cast(-1)) + { + for (std::size_t i = 0; i < len; ++i) + { + get(); + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!get_cbor_string(key) || !sax->key(key))) + { + return false; + } + + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!parse_cbor_internal(true, tag_handler))) + { + return false; + } + key.clear(); + } + } + else + { + while (get() != 0xFF) + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!get_cbor_string(key) || !sax->key(key))) + { + return false; + } + + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!parse_cbor_internal(true, tag_handler))) + { + return false; + } + key.clear(); + } + } + } + + return sax->end_object(); + } + + ///////////// + // MsgPack // + ///////////// + + /*! + @return whether a valid MessagePack value was passed to the SAX parser + */ + bool parse_msgpack_internal() + { + switch (get()) + { + // EOF + case std::char_traits::eof(): + return unexpect_eof(input_format_t::msgpack, "value"); + + // positive fixint + case 0x00: + case 0x01: + case 0x02: + case 0x03: + case 0x04: + case 0x05: + case 0x06: + case 0x07: + case 0x08: + case 0x09: + case 0x0A: + case 0x0B: + case 0x0C: + case 0x0D: + case 0x0E: + case 0x0F: + case 0x10: + case 0x11: + case 0x12: + case 0x13: + case 0x14: + case 0x15: + case 0x16: + case 0x17: + case 0x18: + case 0x19: + case 0x1A: + case 0x1B: + case 0x1C: + case 0x1D: + case 0x1E: + case 0x1F: + case 0x20: + case 0x21: + case 0x22: + case 0x23: + case 0x24: + case 0x25: + case 0x26: + case 0x27: + case 0x28: + case 0x29: + case 0x2A: + case 0x2B: + case 0x2C: + case 0x2D: + case 0x2E: + case 0x2F: + case 0x30: + case 0x31: + case 0x32: + case 0x33: + case 0x34: + case 0x35: + case 0x36: + case 0x37: + case 0x38: + case 0x39: + case 0x3A: + case 0x3B: + case 0x3C: + case 0x3D: + case 0x3E: + case 0x3F: + case 0x40: + case 0x41: + case 0x42: + case 0x43: + case 0x44: + case 0x45: + case 0x46: + case 0x47: + case 0x48: + case 0x49: + case 0x4A: + case 0x4B: + case 0x4C: + case 0x4D: + case 0x4E: + case 0x4F: + case 0x50: + case 0x51: + case 0x52: + case 0x53: + case 0x54: + case 0x55: + case 0x56: + case 0x57: + case 0x58: + case 0x59: + case 0x5A: + case 0x5B: + case 0x5C: + case 0x5D: + case 0x5E: + case 0x5F: + case 0x60: + case 0x61: + case 0x62: + case 0x63: + case 0x64: + case 0x65: + case 0x66: + case 0x67: + case 0x68: + case 0x69: + case 0x6A: + case 0x6B: + case 0x6C: + case 0x6D: + case 0x6E: + case 0x6F: + case 0x70: + case 0x71: + case 0x72: + case 0x73: + case 0x74: + case 0x75: + case 0x76: + case 0x77: + case 0x78: + case 0x79: + case 0x7A: + case 0x7B: + case 0x7C: + case 0x7D: + case 0x7E: + case 0x7F: + return sax->number_unsigned(static_cast(current)); + + // fixmap + case 0x80: + case 0x81: + case 0x82: + case 0x83: + case 0x84: + case 0x85: + case 0x86: + case 0x87: + case 0x88: + case 0x89: + case 0x8A: + case 0x8B: + case 0x8C: + case 0x8D: + case 0x8E: + case 0x8F: + return get_msgpack_object(static_cast(static_cast(current) & 0x0Fu)); + + // fixarray + case 0x90: + case 0x91: + case 0x92: + case 0x93: + case 0x94: + case 0x95: + case 0x96: + case 0x97: + case 0x98: + case 0x99: + case 0x9A: + case 0x9B: + case 0x9C: + case 0x9D: + case 0x9E: + case 0x9F: + return get_msgpack_array(static_cast(static_cast(current) & 0x0Fu)); + + // fixstr + case 0xA0: + case 0xA1: + case 0xA2: + case 0xA3: + case 0xA4: + case 0xA5: + case 0xA6: + case 0xA7: + case 0xA8: + case 0xA9: + case 0xAA: + case 0xAB: + case 0xAC: + case 0xAD: + case 0xAE: + case 0xAF: + case 0xB0: + case 0xB1: + case 0xB2: + case 0xB3: + case 0xB4: + case 0xB5: + case 0xB6: + case 0xB7: + case 0xB8: + case 0xB9: + case 0xBA: + case 0xBB: + case 0xBC: + case 0xBD: + case 0xBE: + case 0xBF: + case 0xD9: // str 8 + case 0xDA: // str 16 + case 0xDB: // str 32 + { + string_t s; + return get_msgpack_string(s) && sax->string(s); + } + + case 0xC0: // nil + return sax->null(); + + case 0xC2: // false + return sax->boolean(false); + + case 0xC3: // true + return sax->boolean(true); + + case 0xC4: // bin 8 + case 0xC5: // bin 16 + case 0xC6: // bin 32 + case 0xC7: // ext 8 + case 0xC8: // ext 16 + case 0xC9: // ext 32 + case 0xD4: // fixext 1 + case 0xD5: // fixext 2 + case 0xD6: // fixext 4 + case 0xD7: // fixext 8 + case 0xD8: // fixext 16 + { + binary_t b; + return get_msgpack_binary(b) && sax->binary(b); + } + + case 0xCA: // float 32 + { + float number{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::msgpack, number) && sax->number_float(static_cast(number), ""); + } + + case 0xCB: // float 64 + { + double number{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::msgpack, number) && sax->number_float(static_cast(number), ""); + } + + case 0xCC: // uint 8 + { + std::uint8_t number{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::msgpack, number) && sax->number_unsigned(number); + } + + case 0xCD: // uint 16 + { + std::uint16_t number{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::msgpack, number) && sax->number_unsigned(number); + } + + case 0xCE: // uint 32 + { + std::uint32_t number{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::msgpack, number) && sax->number_unsigned(number); + } + + case 0xCF: // uint 64 + { + std::uint64_t number{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::msgpack, number) && sax->number_unsigned(number); + } + + case 0xD0: // int 8 + { + std::int8_t number{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::msgpack, number) && sax->number_integer(number); + } + + case 0xD1: // int 16 + { + std::int16_t number{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::msgpack, number) && sax->number_integer(number); + } + + case 0xD2: // int 32 + { + std::int32_t number{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::msgpack, number) && sax->number_integer(number); + } + + case 0xD3: // int 64 + { + std::int64_t number{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::msgpack, number) && sax->number_integer(number); + } + + case 0xDC: // array 16 + { + std::uint16_t len{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::msgpack, len) && get_msgpack_array(static_cast(len)); + } + + case 0xDD: // array 32 + { + std::uint32_t len{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::msgpack, len) && get_msgpack_array(static_cast(len)); + } + + case 0xDE: // map 16 + { + std::uint16_t len{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::msgpack, len) && get_msgpack_object(static_cast(len)); + } + + case 0xDF: // map 32 + { + std::uint32_t len{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::msgpack, len) && get_msgpack_object(static_cast(len)); + } + + // negative fixint + case 0xE0: + case 0xE1: + case 0xE2: + case 0xE3: + case 0xE4: + case 0xE5: + case 0xE6: + case 0xE7: + case 0xE8: + case 0xE9: + case 0xEA: + case 0xEB: + case 0xEC: + case 0xED: + case 0xEE: + case 0xEF: + case 0xF0: + case 0xF1: + case 0xF2: + case 0xF3: + case 0xF4: + case 0xF5: + case 0xF6: + case 0xF7: + case 0xF8: + case 0xF9: + case 0xFA: + case 0xFB: + case 0xFC: + case 0xFD: + case 0xFE: + case 0xFF: + return sax->number_integer(static_cast(current)); + + default: // anything else + { + auto last_token = get_token_string(); + return sax->parse_error(chars_read, last_token, parse_error::create(112, chars_read, exception_message(input_format_t::msgpack, "invalid byte: 0x" + last_token, "value"), BasicJsonType())); + } + } + } + + /*! + @brief reads a MessagePack string + + This function first reads starting bytes to determine the expected + string length and then copies this number of bytes into a string. + + @param[out] result created string + + @return whether string creation completed + */ + bool get_msgpack_string(string_t& result) + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!unexpect_eof(input_format_t::msgpack, "string"))) + { + return false; + } + + switch (current) + { + // fixstr + case 0xA0: + case 0xA1: + case 0xA2: + case 0xA3: + case 0xA4: + case 0xA5: + case 0xA6: + case 0xA7: + case 0xA8: + case 0xA9: + case 0xAA: + case 0xAB: + case 0xAC: + case 0xAD: + case 0xAE: + case 0xAF: + case 0xB0: + case 0xB1: + case 0xB2: + case 0xB3: + case 0xB4: + case 0xB5: + case 0xB6: + case 0xB7: + case 0xB8: + case 0xB9: + case 0xBA: + case 0xBB: + case 0xBC: + case 0xBD: + case 0xBE: + case 0xBF: + { + return get_string(input_format_t::msgpack, static_cast(current) & 0x1Fu, result); + } + + case 0xD9: // str 8 + { + std::uint8_t len{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::msgpack, len) && get_string(input_format_t::msgpack, len, result); + } + + case 0xDA: // str 16 + { + std::uint16_t len{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::msgpack, len) && get_string(input_format_t::msgpack, len, result); + } + + case 0xDB: // str 32 + { + std::uint32_t len{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::msgpack, len) && get_string(input_format_t::msgpack, len, result); + } + + default: + { + auto last_token = get_token_string(); + return sax->parse_error(chars_read, last_token, parse_error::create(113, chars_read, exception_message(input_format_t::msgpack, "expected length specification (0xA0-0xBF, 0xD9-0xDB); last byte: 0x" + last_token, "string"), BasicJsonType())); + } + } + } + + /*! + @brief reads a MessagePack byte array + + This function first reads starting bytes to determine the expected + byte array length and then copies this number of bytes into a byte array. + + @param[out] result created byte array + + @return whether byte array creation completed + */ + bool get_msgpack_binary(binary_t& result) + { + // helper function to set the subtype + auto assign_and_return_true = [&result](std::int8_t subtype) + { + result.set_subtype(static_cast(subtype)); + return true; + }; + + switch (current) + { + case 0xC4: // bin 8 + { + std::uint8_t len{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::msgpack, len) && + get_binary(input_format_t::msgpack, len, result); + } + + case 0xC5: // bin 16 + { + std::uint16_t len{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::msgpack, len) && + get_binary(input_format_t::msgpack, len, result); + } + + case 0xC6: // bin 32 + { + std::uint32_t len{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::msgpack, len) && + get_binary(input_format_t::msgpack, len, result); + } + + case 0xC7: // ext 8 + { + std::uint8_t len{}; + std::int8_t subtype{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::msgpack, len) && + get_number(input_format_t::msgpack, subtype) && + get_binary(input_format_t::msgpack, len, result) && + assign_and_return_true(subtype); + } + + case 0xC8: // ext 16 + { + std::uint16_t len{}; + std::int8_t subtype{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::msgpack, len) && + get_number(input_format_t::msgpack, subtype) && + get_binary(input_format_t::msgpack, len, result) && + assign_and_return_true(subtype); + } + + case 0xC9: // ext 32 + { + std::uint32_t len{}; + std::int8_t subtype{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::msgpack, len) && + get_number(input_format_t::msgpack, subtype) && + get_binary(input_format_t::msgpack, len, result) && + assign_and_return_true(subtype); + } + + case 0xD4: // fixext 1 + { + std::int8_t subtype{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::msgpack, subtype) && + get_binary(input_format_t::msgpack, 1, result) && + assign_and_return_true(subtype); + } + + case 0xD5: // fixext 2 + { + std::int8_t subtype{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::msgpack, subtype) && + get_binary(input_format_t::msgpack, 2, result) && + assign_and_return_true(subtype); + } + + case 0xD6: // fixext 4 + { + std::int8_t subtype{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::msgpack, subtype) && + get_binary(input_format_t::msgpack, 4, result) && + assign_and_return_true(subtype); + } + + case 0xD7: // fixext 8 + { + std::int8_t subtype{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::msgpack, subtype) && + get_binary(input_format_t::msgpack, 8, result) && + assign_and_return_true(subtype); + } + + case 0xD8: // fixext 16 + { + std::int8_t subtype{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::msgpack, subtype) && + get_binary(input_format_t::msgpack, 16, result) && + assign_and_return_true(subtype); + } + + default: // LCOV_EXCL_LINE + return false; // LCOV_EXCL_LINE + } + } + + /*! + @param[in] len the length of the array + @return whether array creation completed + */ + bool get_msgpack_array(const std::size_t len) + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!sax->start_array(len))) + { + return false; + } + + for (std::size_t i = 0; i < len; ++i) + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!parse_msgpack_internal())) + { + return false; + } + } + + return sax->end_array(); + } + + /*! + @param[in] len the length of the object + @return whether object creation completed + */ + bool get_msgpack_object(const std::size_t len) + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!sax->start_object(len))) + { + return false; + } + + string_t key; + for (std::size_t i = 0; i < len; ++i) + { + get(); + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!get_msgpack_string(key) || !sax->key(key))) + { + return false; + } + + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!parse_msgpack_internal())) + { + return false; + } + key.clear(); + } + + return sax->end_object(); + } + + //////////// + // UBJSON // + //////////// + + /*! + @param[in] get_char whether a new character should be retrieved from the + input (true, default) or whether the last read + character should be considered instead + + @return whether a valid UBJSON value was passed to the SAX parser + */ + bool parse_ubjson_internal(const bool get_char = true) + { + return get_ubjson_value(get_char ? get_ignore_noop() : current); + } + + /*! + @brief reads a UBJSON string + + This function is either called after reading the 'S' byte explicitly + indicating a string, or in case of an object key where the 'S' byte can be + left out. + + @param[out] result created string + @param[in] get_char whether a new character should be retrieved from the + input (true, default) or whether the last read + character should be considered instead + + @return whether string creation completed + */ + bool get_ubjson_string(string_t& result, const bool get_char = true) + { + if (get_char) + { + get(); // TODO(niels): may we ignore N here? + } + + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!unexpect_eof(input_format_t::ubjson, "value"))) + { + return false; + } + + switch (current) + { + case 'U': + { + std::uint8_t len{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::ubjson, len) && get_string(input_format_t::ubjson, len, result); + } + + case 'i': + { + std::int8_t len{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::ubjson, len) && get_string(input_format_t::ubjson, len, result); + } + + case 'I': + { + std::int16_t len{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::ubjson, len) && get_string(input_format_t::ubjson, len, result); + } + + case 'l': + { + std::int32_t len{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::ubjson, len) && get_string(input_format_t::ubjson, len, result); + } + + case 'L': + { + std::int64_t len{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::ubjson, len) && get_string(input_format_t::ubjson, len, result); + } + + default: + auto last_token = get_token_string(); + return sax->parse_error(chars_read, last_token, parse_error::create(113, chars_read, exception_message(input_format_t::ubjson, "expected length type specification (U, i, I, l, L); last byte: 0x" + last_token, "string"), BasicJsonType())); + } + } + + /*! + @param[out] result determined size + @return whether size determination completed + */ + bool get_ubjson_size_value(std::size_t& result) + { + switch (get_ignore_noop()) + { + case 'U': + { + std::uint8_t number{}; + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!get_number(input_format_t::ubjson, number))) + { + return false; + } + result = static_cast(number); + return true; + } + + case 'i': + { + std::int8_t number{}; + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!get_number(input_format_t::ubjson, number))) + { + return false; + } + result = static_cast(number); // NOLINT(bugprone-signed-char-misuse,cert-str34-c): number is not a char + return true; + } + + case 'I': + { + std::int16_t number{}; + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!get_number(input_format_t::ubjson, number))) + { + return false; + } + result = static_cast(number); + return true; + } + + case 'l': + { + std::int32_t number{}; + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!get_number(input_format_t::ubjson, number))) + { + return false; + } + result = static_cast(number); + return true; + } + + case 'L': + { + std::int64_t number{}; + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!get_number(input_format_t::ubjson, number))) + { + return false; + } + result = static_cast(number); + return true; + } + + default: + { + auto last_token = get_token_string(); + return sax->parse_error(chars_read, last_token, parse_error::create(113, chars_read, exception_message(input_format_t::ubjson, "expected length type specification (U, i, I, l, L) after '#'; last byte: 0x" + last_token, "size"), BasicJsonType())); + } + } + } + + /*! + @brief determine the type and size for a container + + In the optimized UBJSON format, a type and a size can be provided to allow + for a more compact representation. + + @param[out] result pair of the size and the type + + @return whether pair creation completed + */ + bool get_ubjson_size_type(std::pair& result) + { + result.first = string_t::npos; // size + result.second = 0; // type + + get_ignore_noop(); + + if (current == '$') + { + result.second = get(); // must not ignore 'N', because 'N' maybe the type + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!unexpect_eof(input_format_t::ubjson, "type"))) + { + return false; + } + + get_ignore_noop(); + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(current != '#')) + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!unexpect_eof(input_format_t::ubjson, "value"))) + { + return false; + } + auto last_token = get_token_string(); + return sax->parse_error(chars_read, last_token, parse_error::create(112, chars_read, exception_message(input_format_t::ubjson, "expected '#' after type information; last byte: 0x" + last_token, "size"), BasicJsonType())); + } + + return get_ubjson_size_value(result.first); + } + + if (current == '#') + { + return get_ubjson_size_value(result.first); + } + + return true; + } + + /*! + @param prefix the previously read or set type prefix + @return whether value creation completed + */ + bool get_ubjson_value(const char_int_type prefix) + { + switch (prefix) + { + case std::char_traits::eof(): // EOF + return unexpect_eof(input_format_t::ubjson, "value"); + + case 'T': // true + return sax->boolean(true); + case 'F': // false + return sax->boolean(false); + + case 'Z': // null + return sax->null(); + + case 'U': + { + std::uint8_t number{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::ubjson, number) && sax->number_unsigned(number); + } + + case 'i': + { + std::int8_t number{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::ubjson, number) && sax->number_integer(number); + } + + case 'I': + { + std::int16_t number{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::ubjson, number) && sax->number_integer(number); + } + + case 'l': + { + std::int32_t number{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::ubjson, number) && sax->number_integer(number); + } + + case 'L': + { + std::int64_t number{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::ubjson, number) && sax->number_integer(number); + } + + case 'd': + { + float number{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::ubjson, number) && sax->number_float(static_cast(number), ""); + } + + case 'D': + { + double number{}; + return get_number(input_format_t::ubjson, number) && sax->number_float(static_cast(number), ""); + } + + case 'H': + { + return get_ubjson_high_precision_number(); + } + + case 'C': // char + { + get(); + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!unexpect_eof(input_format_t::ubjson, "char"))) + { + return false; + } + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(current > 127)) + { + auto last_token = get_token_string(); + return sax->parse_error(chars_read, last_token, parse_error::create(113, chars_read, exception_message(input_format_t::ubjson, "byte after 'C' must be in range 0x00..0x7F; last byte: 0x" + last_token, "char"), BasicJsonType())); + } + string_t s(1, static_cast(current)); + return sax->string(s); + } + + case 'S': // string + { + string_t s; + return get_ubjson_string(s) && sax->string(s); + } + + case '[': // array + return get_ubjson_array(); + + case '{': // object + return get_ubjson_object(); + + default: // anything else + { + auto last_token = get_token_string(); + return sax->parse_error(chars_read, last_token, parse_error::create(112, chars_read, exception_message(input_format_t::ubjson, "invalid byte: 0x" + last_token, "value"), BasicJsonType())); + } + } + } + + /*! + @return whether array creation completed + */ + bool get_ubjson_array() + { + std::pair size_and_type; + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!get_ubjson_size_type(size_and_type))) + { + return false; + } + + if (size_and_type.first != string_t::npos) + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!sax->start_array(size_and_type.first))) + { + return false; + } + + if (size_and_type.second != 0) + { + if (size_and_type.second != 'N') + { + for (std::size_t i = 0; i < size_and_type.first; ++i) + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!get_ubjson_value(size_and_type.second))) + { + return false; + } + } + } + } + else + { + for (std::size_t i = 0; i < size_and_type.first; ++i) + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!parse_ubjson_internal())) + { + return false; + } + } + } + } + else + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!sax->start_array(static_cast(-1)))) + { + return false; + } + + while (current != ']') + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!parse_ubjson_internal(false))) + { + return false; + } + get_ignore_noop(); + } + } + + return sax->end_array(); + } + + /*! + @return whether object creation completed + */ + bool get_ubjson_object() + { + std::pair size_and_type; + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!get_ubjson_size_type(size_and_type))) + { + return false; + } + + string_t key; + if (size_and_type.first != string_t::npos) + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!sax->start_object(size_and_type.first))) + { + return false; + } + + if (size_and_type.second != 0) + { + for (std::size_t i = 0; i < size_and_type.first; ++i) + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!get_ubjson_string(key) || !sax->key(key))) + { + return false; + } + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!get_ubjson_value(size_and_type.second))) + { + return false; + } + key.clear(); + } + } + else + { + for (std::size_t i = 0; i < size_and_type.first; ++i) + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!get_ubjson_string(key) || !sax->key(key))) + { + return false; + } + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!parse_ubjson_internal())) + { + return false; + } + key.clear(); + } + } + } + else + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!sax->start_object(static_cast(-1)))) + { + return false; + } + + while (current != '}') + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!get_ubjson_string(key, false) || !sax->key(key))) + { + return false; + } + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!parse_ubjson_internal())) + { + return false; + } + get_ignore_noop(); + key.clear(); + } + } + + return sax->end_object(); + } + + // Note, no reader for UBJSON binary types is implemented because they do + // not exist + + bool get_ubjson_high_precision_number() + { + // get size of following number string + std::size_t size{}; + auto res = get_ubjson_size_value(size); + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!res)) + { + return res; + } + + // get number string + std::vector number_vector; + for (std::size_t i = 0; i < size; ++i) + { + get(); + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!unexpect_eof(input_format_t::ubjson, "number"))) + { + return false; + } + number_vector.push_back(static_cast(current)); + } + + // parse number string + using ia_type = decltype(detail::input_adapter(number_vector)); + auto number_lexer = detail::lexer(detail::input_adapter(number_vector), false); + const auto result_number = number_lexer.scan(); + const auto number_string = number_lexer.get_token_string(); + const auto result_remainder = number_lexer.scan(); + + using token_type = typename detail::lexer_base::token_type; + + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(result_remainder != token_type::end_of_input)) + { + return sax->parse_error(chars_read, number_string, parse_error::create(115, chars_read, exception_message(input_format_t::ubjson, "invalid number text: " + number_lexer.get_token_string(), "high-precision number"), BasicJsonType())); + } + + switch (result_number) + { + case token_type::value_integer: + return sax->number_integer(number_lexer.get_number_integer()); + case token_type::value_unsigned: + return sax->number_unsigned(number_lexer.get_number_unsigned()); + case token_type::value_float: + return sax->number_float(number_lexer.get_number_float(), std::move(number_string)); + case token_type::uninitialized: + case token_type::literal_true: + case token_type::literal_false: + case token_type::literal_null: + case token_type::value_string: + case token_type::begin_array: + case token_type::begin_object: + case token_type::end_array: + case token_type::end_object: + case token_type::name_separator: + case token_type::value_separator: + case token_type::parse_error: + case token_type::end_of_input: + case token_type::literal_or_value: + default: + return sax->parse_error(chars_read, number_string, parse_error::create(115, chars_read, exception_message(input_format_t::ubjson, "invalid number text: " + number_lexer.get_token_string(), "high-precision number"), BasicJsonType())); + } + } + + /////////////////////// + // Utility functions // + /////////////////////// + + /*! + @brief get next character from the input + + This function provides the interface to the used input adapter. It does + not throw in case the input reached EOF, but returns a -'ve valued + `std::char_traits::eof()` in that case. + + @return character read from the input + */ + char_int_type get() + { + ++chars_read; + return current = ia.get_character(); + } + + /*! + @return character read from the input after ignoring all 'N' entries + */ + char_int_type get_ignore_noop() + { + do + { + get(); + } + while (current == 'N'); + + return current; + } + + /* + @brief read a number from the input + + @tparam NumberType the type of the number + @param[in] format the current format (for diagnostics) + @param[out] result number of type @a NumberType + + @return whether conversion completed + + @note This function needs to respect the system's endianness, because + bytes in CBOR, MessagePack, and UBJSON are stored in network order + (big endian) and therefore need reordering on little endian systems. + */ + template + bool get_number(const input_format_t format, NumberType& result) + { + // step 1: read input into array with system's byte order + std::array vec{}; + for (std::size_t i = 0; i < sizeof(NumberType); ++i) + { + get(); + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!unexpect_eof(format, "number"))) + { + return false; + } + + // reverse byte order prior to conversion if necessary + if (is_little_endian != InputIsLittleEndian) + { + vec[sizeof(NumberType) - i - 1] = static_cast(current); + } + else + { + vec[i] = static_cast(current); // LCOV_EXCL_LINE + } + } + + // step 2: convert array into number of type T and return + std::memcpy(&result, vec.data(), sizeof(NumberType)); + return true; + } + + /*! + @brief create a string by reading characters from the input + + @tparam NumberType the type of the number + @param[in] format the current format (for diagnostics) + @param[in] len number of characters to read + @param[out] result string created by reading @a len bytes + + @return whether string creation completed + + @note We can not reserve @a len bytes for the result, because @a len + may be too large. Usually, @ref unexpect_eof() detects the end of + the input before we run out of string memory. + */ + template + bool get_string(const input_format_t format, + const NumberType len, + string_t& result) + { + bool success = true; + for (NumberType i = 0; i < len; i++) + { + get(); + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!unexpect_eof(format, "string"))) + { + success = false; + break; + } + result.push_back(static_cast(current)); + } + return success; + } + + /*! + @brief create a byte array by reading bytes from the input + + @tparam NumberType the type of the number + @param[in] format the current format (for diagnostics) + @param[in] len number of bytes to read + @param[out] result byte array created by reading @a len bytes + + @return whether byte array creation completed + + @note We can not reserve @a len bytes for the result, because @a len + may be too large. Usually, @ref unexpect_eof() detects the end of + the input before we run out of memory. + */ + template + bool get_binary(const input_format_t format, + const NumberType len, + binary_t& result) + { + bool success = true; + for (NumberType i = 0; i < len; i++) + { + get(); + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!unexpect_eof(format, "binary"))) + { + success = false; + break; + } + result.push_back(static_cast(current)); + } + return success; + } + + /*! + @param[in] format the current format (for diagnostics) + @param[in] context further context information (for diagnostics) + @return whether the last read character is not EOF + */ + JSON_HEDLEY_NON_NULL(3) + bool unexpect_eof(const input_format_t format, const char* context) const + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(current == std::char_traits::eof())) + { + return sax->parse_error(chars_read, "", + parse_error::create(110, chars_read, exception_message(format, "unexpected end of input", context), BasicJsonType())); + } + return true; + } + + /*! + @return a string representation of the last read byte + */ + std::string get_token_string() const + { + std::array cr{{}}; + static_cast((std::snprintf)(cr.data(), cr.size(), "%.2hhX", static_cast(current))); // NOLINT(cppcoreguidelines-pro-type-vararg,hicpp-vararg) + return std::string{cr.data()}; + } + + /*! + @param[in] format the current format + @param[in] detail a detailed error message + @param[in] context further context information + @return a message string to use in the parse_error exceptions + */ + std::string exception_message(const input_format_t format, + const std::string& detail, + const std::string& context) const + { + std::string error_msg = "syntax error while parsing "; + + switch (format) + { + case input_format_t::cbor: + error_msg += "CBOR"; + break; + + case input_format_t::msgpack: + error_msg += "MessagePack"; + break; + + case input_format_t::ubjson: + error_msg += "UBJSON"; + break; + + case input_format_t::bson: + error_msg += "BSON"; + break; + + case input_format_t::json: // LCOV_EXCL_LINE + default: // LCOV_EXCL_LINE + JSON_ASSERT(false); // NOLINT(cert-dcl03-c,hicpp-static-assert,misc-static-assert) LCOV_EXCL_LINE + } + + return error_msg + " " + context + ": " + detail; + } + + private: + /// input adapter + InputAdapterType ia; + + /// the current character + char_int_type current = std::char_traits::eof(); + + /// the number of characters read + std::size_t chars_read = 0; + + /// whether we can assume little endianness + const bool is_little_endian = little_endianness(); + + /// the SAX parser + json_sax_t* sax = nullptr; +}; +} // namespace detail +} // namespace nlohmann + +// #include + +// #include + +// #include + + +#include // isfinite +#include // uint8_t +#include // function +#include // string +#include // move +#include // vector + +// #include + +// #include + +// #include + +// #include + +// #include + +// #include + +// #include + + +namespace nlohmann +{ +namespace detail +{ +//////////// +// parser // +//////////// + +enum class parse_event_t : std::uint8_t +{ + /// the parser read `{` and started to process a JSON object + object_start, + /// the parser read `}` and finished processing a JSON object + object_end, + /// the parser read `[` and started to process a JSON array + array_start, + /// the parser read `]` and finished processing a JSON array + array_end, + /// the parser read a key of a value in an object + key, + /// the parser finished reading a JSON value + value +}; + +template +using parser_callback_t = + std::function; + +/*! +@brief syntax analysis + +This class implements a recursive descent parser. +*/ +template +class parser +{ + using number_integer_t = typename BasicJsonType::number_integer_t; + using number_unsigned_t = typename BasicJsonType::number_unsigned_t; + using number_float_t = typename BasicJsonType::number_float_t; + using string_t = typename BasicJsonType::string_t; + using lexer_t = lexer; + using token_type = typename lexer_t::token_type; + + public: + /// a parser reading from an input adapter + explicit parser(InputAdapterType&& adapter, + const parser_callback_t cb = nullptr, + const bool allow_exceptions_ = true, + const bool skip_comments = false) + : callback(cb) + , m_lexer(std::move(adapter), skip_comments) + , allow_exceptions(allow_exceptions_) + { + // read first token + get_token(); + } + + /*! + @brief public parser interface + + @param[in] strict whether to expect the last token to be EOF + @param[in,out] result parsed JSON value + + @throw parse_error.101 in case of an unexpected token + @throw parse_error.102 if to_unicode fails or surrogate error + @throw parse_error.103 if to_unicode fails + */ + void parse(const bool strict, BasicJsonType& result) + { + if (callback) + { + json_sax_dom_callback_parser sdp(result, callback, allow_exceptions); + sax_parse_internal(&sdp); + + // in strict mode, input must be completely read + if (strict && (get_token() != token_type::end_of_input)) + { + sdp.parse_error(m_lexer.get_position(), + m_lexer.get_token_string(), + parse_error::create(101, m_lexer.get_position(), + exception_message(token_type::end_of_input, "value"), BasicJsonType())); + } + + // in case of an error, return discarded value + if (sdp.is_errored()) + { + result = value_t::discarded; + return; + } + + // set top-level value to null if it was discarded by the callback + // function + if (result.is_discarded()) + { + result = nullptr; + } + } + else + { + json_sax_dom_parser sdp(result, allow_exceptions); + sax_parse_internal(&sdp); + + // in strict mode, input must be completely read + if (strict && (get_token() != token_type::end_of_input)) + { + sdp.parse_error(m_lexer.get_position(), + m_lexer.get_token_string(), + parse_error::create(101, m_lexer.get_position(), exception_message(token_type::end_of_input, "value"), BasicJsonType())); + } + + // in case of an error, return discarded value + if (sdp.is_errored()) + { + result = value_t::discarded; + return; + } + } + + result.assert_invariant(); + } + + /*! + @brief public accept interface + + @param[in] strict whether to expect the last token to be EOF + @return whether the input is a proper JSON text + */ + bool accept(const bool strict = true) + { + json_sax_acceptor sax_acceptor; + return sax_parse(&sax_acceptor, strict); + } + + template + JSON_HEDLEY_NON_NULL(2) + bool sax_parse(SAX* sax, const bool strict = true) + { + (void)detail::is_sax_static_asserts {}; + const bool result = sax_parse_internal(sax); + + // strict mode: next byte must be EOF + if (result && strict && (get_token() != token_type::end_of_input)) + { + return sax->parse_error(m_lexer.get_position(), + m_lexer.get_token_string(), + parse_error::create(101, m_lexer.get_position(), exception_message(token_type::end_of_input, "value"), BasicJsonType())); + } + + return result; + } + + private: + template + JSON_HEDLEY_NON_NULL(2) + bool sax_parse_internal(SAX* sax) + { + // stack to remember the hierarchy of structured values we are parsing + // true = array; false = object + std::vector states; + // value to avoid a goto (see comment where set to true) + bool skip_to_state_evaluation = false; + + while (true) + { + if (!skip_to_state_evaluation) + { + // invariant: get_token() was called before each iteration + switch (last_token) + { + case token_type::begin_object: + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!sax->start_object(static_cast(-1)))) + { + return false; + } + + // closing } -> we are done + if (get_token() == token_type::end_object) + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!sax->end_object())) + { + return false; + } + break; + } + + // parse key + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(last_token != token_type::value_string)) + { + return sax->parse_error(m_lexer.get_position(), + m_lexer.get_token_string(), + parse_error::create(101, m_lexer.get_position(), exception_message(token_type::value_string, "object key"), BasicJsonType())); + } + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!sax->key(m_lexer.get_string()))) + { + return false; + } + + // parse separator (:) + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(get_token() != token_type::name_separator)) + { + return sax->parse_error(m_lexer.get_position(), + m_lexer.get_token_string(), + parse_error::create(101, m_lexer.get_position(), exception_message(token_type::name_separator, "object separator"), BasicJsonType())); + } + + // remember we are now inside an object + states.push_back(false); + + // parse values + get_token(); + continue; + } + + case token_type::begin_array: + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!sax->start_array(static_cast(-1)))) + { + return false; + } + + // closing ] -> we are done + if (get_token() == token_type::end_array) + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!sax->end_array())) + { + return false; + } + break; + } + + // remember we are now inside an array + states.push_back(true); + + // parse values (no need to call get_token) + continue; + } + + case token_type::value_float: + { + const auto res = m_lexer.get_number_float(); + + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!std::isfinite(res))) + { + return sax->parse_error(m_lexer.get_position(), + m_lexer.get_token_string(), + out_of_range::create(406, "number overflow parsing '" + m_lexer.get_token_string() + "'", BasicJsonType())); + } + + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!sax->number_float(res, m_lexer.get_string()))) + { + return false; + } + + break; + } + + case token_type::literal_false: + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!sax->boolean(false))) + { + return false; + } + break; + } + + case token_type::literal_null: + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!sax->null())) + { + return false; + } + break; + } + + case token_type::literal_true: + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!sax->boolean(true))) + { + return false; + } + break; + } + + case token_type::value_integer: + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!sax->number_integer(m_lexer.get_number_integer()))) + { + return false; + } + break; + } + + case token_type::value_string: + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!sax->string(m_lexer.get_string()))) + { + return false; + } + break; + } + + case token_type::value_unsigned: + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!sax->number_unsigned(m_lexer.get_number_unsigned()))) + { + return false; + } + break; + } + + case token_type::parse_error: + { + // using "uninitialized" to avoid "expected" message + return sax->parse_error(m_lexer.get_position(), + m_lexer.get_token_string(), + parse_error::create(101, m_lexer.get_position(), exception_message(token_type::uninitialized, "value"), BasicJsonType())); + } + + case token_type::uninitialized: + case token_type::end_array: + case token_type::end_object: + case token_type::name_separator: + case token_type::value_separator: + case token_type::end_of_input: + case token_type::literal_or_value: + default: // the last token was unexpected + { + return sax->parse_error(m_lexer.get_position(), + m_lexer.get_token_string(), + parse_error::create(101, m_lexer.get_position(), exception_message(token_type::literal_or_value, "value"), BasicJsonType())); + } + } + } + else + { + skip_to_state_evaluation = false; + } + + // we reached this line after we successfully parsed a value + if (states.empty()) + { + // empty stack: we reached the end of the hierarchy: done + return true; + } + + if (states.back()) // array + { + // comma -> next value + if (get_token() == token_type::value_separator) + { + // parse a new value + get_token(); + continue; + } + + // closing ] + if (JSON_HEDLEY_LIKELY(last_token == token_type::end_array)) + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!sax->end_array())) + { + return false; + } + + // We are done with this array. Before we can parse a + // new value, we need to evaluate the new state first. + // By setting skip_to_state_evaluation to false, we + // are effectively jumping to the beginning of this if. + JSON_ASSERT(!states.empty()); + states.pop_back(); + skip_to_state_evaluation = true; + continue; + } + + return sax->parse_error(m_lexer.get_position(), + m_lexer.get_token_string(), + parse_error::create(101, m_lexer.get_position(), exception_message(token_type::end_array, "array"), BasicJsonType())); + } + + // states.back() is false -> object + + // comma -> next value + if (get_token() == token_type::value_separator) + { + // parse key + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(get_token() != token_type::value_string)) + { + return sax->parse_error(m_lexer.get_position(), + m_lexer.get_token_string(), + parse_error::create(101, m_lexer.get_position(), exception_message(token_type::value_string, "object key"), BasicJsonType())); + } + + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!sax->key(m_lexer.get_string()))) + { + return false; + } + + // parse separator (:) + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(get_token() != token_type::name_separator)) + { + return sax->parse_error(m_lexer.get_position(), + m_lexer.get_token_string(), + parse_error::create(101, m_lexer.get_position(), exception_message(token_type::name_separator, "object separator"), BasicJsonType())); + } + + // parse values + get_token(); + continue; + } + + // closing } + if (JSON_HEDLEY_LIKELY(last_token == token_type::end_object)) + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!sax->end_object())) + { + return false; + } + + // We are done with this object. Before we can parse a + // new value, we need to evaluate the new state first. + // By setting skip_to_state_evaluation to false, we + // are effectively jumping to the beginning of this if. + JSON_ASSERT(!states.empty()); + states.pop_back(); + skip_to_state_evaluation = true; + continue; + } + + return sax->parse_error(m_lexer.get_position(), + m_lexer.get_token_string(), + parse_error::create(101, m_lexer.get_position(), exception_message(token_type::end_object, "object"), BasicJsonType())); + } + } + + /// get next token from lexer + token_type get_token() + { + return last_token = m_lexer.scan(); + } + + std::string exception_message(const token_type expected, const std::string& context) + { + std::string error_msg = "syntax error "; + + if (!context.empty()) + { + error_msg += "while parsing " + context + " "; + } + + error_msg += "- "; + + if (last_token == token_type::parse_error) + { + error_msg += std::string(m_lexer.get_error_message()) + "; last read: '" + + m_lexer.get_token_string() + "'"; + } + else + { + error_msg += "unexpected " + std::string(lexer_t::token_type_name(last_token)); + } + + if (expected != token_type::uninitialized) + { + error_msg += "; expected " + std::string(lexer_t::token_type_name(expected)); + } + + return error_msg; + } + + private: + /// callback function + const parser_callback_t callback = nullptr; + /// the type of the last read token + token_type last_token = token_type::uninitialized; + /// the lexer + lexer_t m_lexer; + /// whether to throw exceptions in case of errors + const bool allow_exceptions = true; +}; + +} // namespace detail +} // namespace nlohmann + +// #include + + +// #include + + +#include // ptrdiff_t +#include // numeric_limits + +// #include + + +namespace nlohmann +{ +namespace detail +{ +/* +@brief an iterator for primitive JSON types + +This class models an iterator for primitive JSON types (boolean, number, +string). It's only purpose is to allow the iterator/const_iterator classes +to "iterate" over primitive values. Internally, the iterator is modeled by +a `difference_type` variable. Value begin_value (`0`) models the begin, +end_value (`1`) models past the end. +*/ +class primitive_iterator_t +{ + private: + using difference_type = std::ptrdiff_t; + static constexpr difference_type begin_value = 0; + static constexpr difference_type end_value = begin_value + 1; + + JSON_PRIVATE_UNLESS_TESTED: + /// iterator as signed integer type + difference_type m_it = (std::numeric_limits::min)(); + + public: + constexpr difference_type get_value() const noexcept + { + return m_it; + } + + /// set iterator to a defined beginning + void set_begin() noexcept + { + m_it = begin_value; + } + + /// set iterator to a defined past the end + void set_end() noexcept + { + m_it = end_value; + } + + /// return whether the iterator can be dereferenced + constexpr bool is_begin() const noexcept + { + return m_it == begin_value; + } + + /// return whether the iterator is at end + constexpr bool is_end() const noexcept + { + return m_it == end_value; + } + + friend constexpr bool operator==(primitive_iterator_t lhs, primitive_iterator_t rhs) noexcept + { + return lhs.m_it == rhs.m_it; + } + + friend constexpr bool operator<(primitive_iterator_t lhs, primitive_iterator_t rhs) noexcept + { + return lhs.m_it < rhs.m_it; + } + + primitive_iterator_t operator+(difference_type n) noexcept + { + auto result = *this; + result += n; + return result; + } + + friend constexpr difference_type operator-(primitive_iterator_t lhs, primitive_iterator_t rhs) noexcept + { + return lhs.m_it - rhs.m_it; + } + + primitive_iterator_t& operator++() noexcept + { + ++m_it; + return *this; + } + + primitive_iterator_t const operator++(int) noexcept // NOLINT(readability-const-return-type) + { + auto result = *this; + ++m_it; + return result; + } + + primitive_iterator_t& operator--() noexcept + { + --m_it; + return *this; + } + + primitive_iterator_t const operator--(int) noexcept // NOLINT(readability-const-return-type) + { + auto result = *this; + --m_it; + return result; + } + + primitive_iterator_t& operator+=(difference_type n) noexcept + { + m_it += n; + return *this; + } + + primitive_iterator_t& operator-=(difference_type n) noexcept + { + m_it -= n; + return *this; + } +}; +} // namespace detail +} // namespace nlohmann + + +namespace nlohmann +{ +namespace detail +{ +/*! +@brief an iterator value + +@note This structure could easily be a union, but MSVC currently does not allow +unions members with complex constructors, see https://github.com/nlohmann/json/pull/105. +*/ +template struct internal_iterator +{ + /// iterator for JSON objects + typename BasicJsonType::object_t::iterator object_iterator {}; + /// iterator for JSON arrays + typename BasicJsonType::array_t::iterator array_iterator {}; + /// generic iterator for all other types + primitive_iterator_t primitive_iterator {}; +}; +} // namespace detail +} // namespace nlohmann + +// #include + + +#include // iterator, random_access_iterator_tag, bidirectional_iterator_tag, advance, next +#include // conditional, is_const, remove_const + +// #include + +// #include + +// #include + +// #include + +// #include + +// #include + +// #include + + +namespace nlohmann +{ +namespace detail +{ +// forward declare, to be able to friend it later on +template class iteration_proxy; +template class iteration_proxy_value; + +/*! +@brief a template for a bidirectional iterator for the @ref basic_json class +This class implements a both iterators (iterator and const_iterator) for the +@ref basic_json class. +@note An iterator is called *initialized* when a pointer to a JSON value has + been set (e.g., by a constructor or a copy assignment). If the iterator is + default-constructed, it is *uninitialized* and most methods are undefined. + **The library uses assertions to detect calls on uninitialized iterators.** +@requirement The class satisfies the following concept requirements: +- +[BidirectionalIterator](https://en.cppreference.com/w/cpp/named_req/BidirectionalIterator): + The iterator that can be moved can be moved in both directions (i.e. + incremented and decremented). +@since version 1.0.0, simplified in version 2.0.9, change to bidirectional + iterators in version 3.0.0 (see https://github.com/nlohmann/json/issues/593) +*/ +template +class iter_impl // NOLINT(cppcoreguidelines-special-member-functions,hicpp-special-member-functions) +{ + /// the iterator with BasicJsonType of different const-ness + using other_iter_impl = iter_impl::value, typename std::remove_const::type, const BasicJsonType>::type>; + /// allow basic_json to access private members + friend other_iter_impl; + friend BasicJsonType; + friend iteration_proxy; + friend iteration_proxy_value; + + using object_t = typename BasicJsonType::object_t; + using array_t = typename BasicJsonType::array_t; + // make sure BasicJsonType is basic_json or const basic_json + static_assert(is_basic_json::type>::value, + "iter_impl only accepts (const) basic_json"); + + public: + + /// The std::iterator class template (used as a base class to provide typedefs) is deprecated in C++17. + /// The C++ Standard has never required user-defined iterators to derive from std::iterator. + /// A user-defined iterator should provide publicly accessible typedefs named + /// iterator_category, value_type, difference_type, pointer, and reference. + /// Note that value_type is required to be non-const, even for constant iterators. + using iterator_category = std::bidirectional_iterator_tag; + + /// the type of the values when the iterator is dereferenced + using value_type = typename BasicJsonType::value_type; + /// a type to represent differences between iterators + using difference_type = typename BasicJsonType::difference_type; + /// defines a pointer to the type iterated over (value_type) + using pointer = typename std::conditional::value, + typename BasicJsonType::const_pointer, + typename BasicJsonType::pointer>::type; + /// defines a reference to the type iterated over (value_type) + using reference = + typename std::conditional::value, + typename BasicJsonType::const_reference, + typename BasicJsonType::reference>::type; + + iter_impl() = default; + ~iter_impl() = default; + iter_impl(iter_impl&&) noexcept = default; + iter_impl& operator=(iter_impl&&) noexcept = default; + + /*! + @brief constructor for a given JSON instance + @param[in] object pointer to a JSON object for this iterator + @pre object != nullptr + @post The iterator is initialized; i.e. `m_object != nullptr`. + */ + explicit iter_impl(pointer object) noexcept : m_object(object) + { + JSON_ASSERT(m_object != nullptr); + + switch (m_object->m_type) + { + case value_t::object: + { + m_it.object_iterator = typename object_t::iterator(); + break; + } + + case value_t::array: + { + m_it.array_iterator = typename array_t::iterator(); + break; + } + + case value_t::null: + case value_t::string: + case value_t::boolean: + case value_t::number_integer: + case value_t::number_unsigned: + case value_t::number_float: + case value_t::binary: + case value_t::discarded: + default: + { + m_it.primitive_iterator = primitive_iterator_t(); + break; + } + } + } + + /*! + @note The conventional copy constructor and copy assignment are implicitly + defined. Combined with the following converting constructor and + assignment, they support: (1) copy from iterator to iterator, (2) + copy from const iterator to const iterator, and (3) conversion from + iterator to const iterator. However conversion from const iterator + to iterator is not defined. + */ + + /*! + @brief const copy constructor + @param[in] other const iterator to copy from + @note This copy constructor had to be defined explicitly to circumvent a bug + occurring on msvc v19.0 compiler (VS 2015) debug build. For more + information refer to: https://github.com/nlohmann/json/issues/1608 + */ + iter_impl(const iter_impl& other) noexcept + : m_object(other.m_object), m_it(other.m_it) + {} + + /*! + @brief converting assignment + @param[in] other const iterator to copy from + @return const/non-const iterator + @note It is not checked whether @a other is initialized. + */ + iter_impl& operator=(const iter_impl& other) noexcept + { + if (&other != this) + { + m_object = other.m_object; + m_it = other.m_it; + } + return *this; + } + + /*! + @brief converting constructor + @param[in] other non-const iterator to copy from + @note It is not checked whether @a other is initialized. + */ + iter_impl(const iter_impl::type>& other) noexcept + : m_object(other.m_object), m_it(other.m_it) + {} + + /*! + @brief converting assignment + @param[in] other non-const iterator to copy from + @return const/non-const iterator + @note It is not checked whether @a other is initialized. + */ + iter_impl& operator=(const iter_impl::type>& other) noexcept // NOLINT(cert-oop54-cpp) + { + m_object = other.m_object; + m_it = other.m_it; + return *this; + } + + JSON_PRIVATE_UNLESS_TESTED: + /*! + @brief set the iterator to the first value + @pre The iterator is initialized; i.e. `m_object != nullptr`. + */ + void set_begin() noexcept + { + JSON_ASSERT(m_object != nullptr); + + switch (m_object->m_type) + { + case value_t::object: + { + m_it.object_iterator = m_object->m_value.object->begin(); + break; + } + + case value_t::array: + { + m_it.array_iterator = m_object->m_value.array->begin(); + break; + } + + case value_t::null: + { + // set to end so begin()==end() is true: null is empty + m_it.primitive_iterator.set_end(); + break; + } + + case value_t::string: + case value_t::boolean: + case value_t::number_integer: + case value_t::number_unsigned: + case value_t::number_float: + case value_t::binary: + case value_t::discarded: + default: + { + m_it.primitive_iterator.set_begin(); + break; + } + } + } + + /*! + @brief set the iterator past the last value + @pre The iterator is initialized; i.e. `m_object != nullptr`. + */ + void set_end() noexcept + { + JSON_ASSERT(m_object != nullptr); + + switch (m_object->m_type) + { + case value_t::object: + { + m_it.object_iterator = m_object->m_value.object->end(); + break; + } + + case value_t::array: + { + m_it.array_iterator = m_object->m_value.array->end(); + break; + } + + case value_t::null: + case value_t::string: + case value_t::boolean: + case value_t::number_integer: + case value_t::number_unsigned: + case value_t::number_float: + case value_t::binary: + case value_t::discarded: + default: + { + m_it.primitive_iterator.set_end(); + break; + } + } + } + + public: + /*! + @brief return a reference to the value pointed to by the iterator + @pre The iterator is initialized; i.e. `m_object != nullptr`. + */ + reference operator*() const + { + JSON_ASSERT(m_object != nullptr); + + switch (m_object->m_type) + { + case value_t::object: + { + JSON_ASSERT(m_it.object_iterator != m_object->m_value.object->end()); + return m_it.object_iterator->second; + } + + case value_t::array: + { + JSON_ASSERT(m_it.array_iterator != m_object->m_value.array->end()); + return *m_it.array_iterator; + } + + case value_t::null: + JSON_THROW(invalid_iterator::create(214, "cannot get value", *m_object)); + + case value_t::string: + case value_t::boolean: + case value_t::number_integer: + case value_t::number_unsigned: + case value_t::number_float: + case value_t::binary: + case value_t::discarded: + default: + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_LIKELY(m_it.primitive_iterator.is_begin())) + { + return *m_object; + } + + JSON_THROW(invalid_iterator::create(214, "cannot get value", *m_object)); + } + } + } + + /*! + @brief dereference the iterator + @pre The iterator is initialized; i.e. `m_object != nullptr`. + */ + pointer operator->() const + { + JSON_ASSERT(m_object != nullptr); + + switch (m_object->m_type) + { + case value_t::object: + { + JSON_ASSERT(m_it.object_iterator != m_object->m_value.object->end()); + return &(m_it.object_iterator->second); + } + + case value_t::array: + { + JSON_ASSERT(m_it.array_iterator != m_object->m_value.array->end()); + return &*m_it.array_iterator; + } + + case value_t::null: + case value_t::string: + case value_t::boolean: + case value_t::number_integer: + case value_t::number_unsigned: + case value_t::number_float: + case value_t::binary: + case value_t::discarded: + default: + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_LIKELY(m_it.primitive_iterator.is_begin())) + { + return m_object; + } + + JSON_THROW(invalid_iterator::create(214, "cannot get value", *m_object)); + } + } + } + + /*! + @brief post-increment (it++) + @pre The iterator is initialized; i.e. `m_object != nullptr`. + */ + iter_impl const operator++(int) // NOLINT(readability-const-return-type) + { + auto result = *this; + ++(*this); + return result; + } + + /*! + @brief pre-increment (++it) + @pre The iterator is initialized; i.e. `m_object != nullptr`. + */ + iter_impl& operator++() + { + JSON_ASSERT(m_object != nullptr); + + switch (m_object->m_type) + { + case value_t::object: + { + std::advance(m_it.object_iterator, 1); + break; + } + + case value_t::array: + { + std::advance(m_it.array_iterator, 1); + break; + } + + case value_t::null: + case value_t::string: + case value_t::boolean: + case value_t::number_integer: + case value_t::number_unsigned: + case value_t::number_float: + case value_t::binary: + case value_t::discarded: + default: + { + ++m_it.primitive_iterator; + break; + } + } + + return *this; + } + + /*! + @brief post-decrement (it--) + @pre The iterator is initialized; i.e. `m_object != nullptr`. + */ + iter_impl const operator--(int) // NOLINT(readability-const-return-type) + { + auto result = *this; + --(*this); + return result; + } + + /*! + @brief pre-decrement (--it) + @pre The iterator is initialized; i.e. `m_object != nullptr`. + */ + iter_impl& operator--() + { + JSON_ASSERT(m_object != nullptr); + + switch (m_object->m_type) + { + case value_t::object: + { + std::advance(m_it.object_iterator, -1); + break; + } + + case value_t::array: + { + std::advance(m_it.array_iterator, -1); + break; + } + + case value_t::null: + case value_t::string: + case value_t::boolean: + case value_t::number_integer: + case value_t::number_unsigned: + case value_t::number_float: + case value_t::binary: + case value_t::discarded: + default: + { + --m_it.primitive_iterator; + break; + } + } + + return *this; + } + + /*! + @brief comparison: equal + @pre The iterator is initialized; i.e. `m_object != nullptr`. + */ + template < typename IterImpl, detail::enable_if_t < (std::is_same::value || std::is_same::value), std::nullptr_t > = nullptr > + bool operator==(const IterImpl& other) const + { + // if objects are not the same, the comparison is undefined + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(m_object != other.m_object)) + { + JSON_THROW(invalid_iterator::create(212, "cannot compare iterators of different containers", *m_object)); + } + + JSON_ASSERT(m_object != nullptr); + + switch (m_object->m_type) + { + case value_t::object: + return (m_it.object_iterator == other.m_it.object_iterator); + + case value_t::array: + return (m_it.array_iterator == other.m_it.array_iterator); + + case value_t::null: + case value_t::string: + case value_t::boolean: + case value_t::number_integer: + case value_t::number_unsigned: + case value_t::number_float: + case value_t::binary: + case value_t::discarded: + default: + return (m_it.primitive_iterator == other.m_it.primitive_iterator); + } + } + + /*! + @brief comparison: not equal + @pre The iterator is initialized; i.e. `m_object != nullptr`. + */ + template < typename IterImpl, detail::enable_if_t < (std::is_same::value || std::is_same::value), std::nullptr_t > = nullptr > + bool operator!=(const IterImpl& other) const + { + return !operator==(other); + } + + /*! + @brief comparison: smaller + @pre The iterator is initialized; i.e. `m_object != nullptr`. + */ + bool operator<(const iter_impl& other) const + { + // if objects are not the same, the comparison is undefined + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(m_object != other.m_object)) + { + JSON_THROW(invalid_iterator::create(212, "cannot compare iterators of different containers", *m_object)); + } + + JSON_ASSERT(m_object != nullptr); + + switch (m_object->m_type) + { + case value_t::object: + JSON_THROW(invalid_iterator::create(213, "cannot compare order of object iterators", *m_object)); + + case value_t::array: + return (m_it.array_iterator < other.m_it.array_iterator); + + case value_t::null: + case value_t::string: + case value_t::boolean: + case value_t::number_integer: + case value_t::number_unsigned: + case value_t::number_float: + case value_t::binary: + case value_t::discarded: + default: + return (m_it.primitive_iterator < other.m_it.primitive_iterator); + } + } + + /*! + @brief comparison: less than or equal + @pre The iterator is initialized; i.e. `m_object != nullptr`. + */ + bool operator<=(const iter_impl& other) const + { + return !other.operator < (*this); + } + + /*! + @brief comparison: greater than + @pre The iterator is initialized; i.e. `m_object != nullptr`. + */ + bool operator>(const iter_impl& other) const + { + return !operator<=(other); + } + + /*! + @brief comparison: greater than or equal + @pre The iterator is initialized; i.e. `m_object != nullptr`. + */ + bool operator>=(const iter_impl& other) const + { + return !operator<(other); + } + + /*! + @brief add to iterator + @pre The iterator is initialized; i.e. `m_object != nullptr`. + */ + iter_impl& operator+=(difference_type i) + { + JSON_ASSERT(m_object != nullptr); + + switch (m_object->m_type) + { + case value_t::object: + JSON_THROW(invalid_iterator::create(209, "cannot use offsets with object iterators", *m_object)); + + case value_t::array: + { + std::advance(m_it.array_iterator, i); + break; + } + + case value_t::null: + case value_t::string: + case value_t::boolean: + case value_t::number_integer: + case value_t::number_unsigned: + case value_t::number_float: + case value_t::binary: + case value_t::discarded: + default: + { + m_it.primitive_iterator += i; + break; + } + } + + return *this; + } + + /*! + @brief subtract from iterator + @pre The iterator is initialized; i.e. `m_object != nullptr`. + */ + iter_impl& operator-=(difference_type i) + { + return operator+=(-i); + } + + /*! + @brief add to iterator + @pre The iterator is initialized; i.e. `m_object != nullptr`. + */ + iter_impl operator+(difference_type i) const + { + auto result = *this; + result += i; + return result; + } + + /*! + @brief addition of distance and iterator + @pre The iterator is initialized; i.e. `m_object != nullptr`. + */ + friend iter_impl operator+(difference_type i, const iter_impl& it) + { + auto result = it; + result += i; + return result; + } + + /*! + @brief subtract from iterator + @pre The iterator is initialized; i.e. `m_object != nullptr`. + */ + iter_impl operator-(difference_type i) const + { + auto result = *this; + result -= i; + return result; + } + + /*! + @brief return difference + @pre The iterator is initialized; i.e. `m_object != nullptr`. + */ + difference_type operator-(const iter_impl& other) const + { + JSON_ASSERT(m_object != nullptr); + + switch (m_object->m_type) + { + case value_t::object: + JSON_THROW(invalid_iterator::create(209, "cannot use offsets with object iterators", *m_object)); + + case value_t::array: + return m_it.array_iterator - other.m_it.array_iterator; + + case value_t::null: + case value_t::string: + case value_t::boolean: + case value_t::number_integer: + case value_t::number_unsigned: + case value_t::number_float: + case value_t::binary: + case value_t::discarded: + default: + return m_it.primitive_iterator - other.m_it.primitive_iterator; + } + } + + /*! + @brief access to successor + @pre The iterator is initialized; i.e. `m_object != nullptr`. + */ + reference operator[](difference_type n) const + { + JSON_ASSERT(m_object != nullptr); + + switch (m_object->m_type) + { + case value_t::object: + JSON_THROW(invalid_iterator::create(208, "cannot use operator[] for object iterators", *m_object)); + + case value_t::array: + return *std::next(m_it.array_iterator, n); + + case value_t::null: + JSON_THROW(invalid_iterator::create(214, "cannot get value", *m_object)); + + case value_t::string: + case value_t::boolean: + case value_t::number_integer: + case value_t::number_unsigned: + case value_t::number_float: + case value_t::binary: + case value_t::discarded: + default: + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_LIKELY(m_it.primitive_iterator.get_value() == -n)) + { + return *m_object; + } + + JSON_THROW(invalid_iterator::create(214, "cannot get value", *m_object)); + } + } + } + + /*! + @brief return the key of an object iterator + @pre The iterator is initialized; i.e. `m_object != nullptr`. + */ + const typename object_t::key_type& key() const + { + JSON_ASSERT(m_object != nullptr); + + if (JSON_HEDLEY_LIKELY(m_object->is_object())) + { + return m_it.object_iterator->first; + } + + JSON_THROW(invalid_iterator::create(207, "cannot use key() for non-object iterators", *m_object)); + } + + /*! + @brief return the value of an iterator + @pre The iterator is initialized; i.e. `m_object != nullptr`. + */ + reference value() const + { + return operator*(); + } + + JSON_PRIVATE_UNLESS_TESTED: + /// associated JSON instance + pointer m_object = nullptr; + /// the actual iterator of the associated instance + internal_iterator::type> m_it {}; +}; +} // namespace detail +} // namespace nlohmann + +// #include + +// #include + + +#include // ptrdiff_t +#include // reverse_iterator +#include // declval + +namespace nlohmann +{ +namespace detail +{ +////////////////////// +// reverse_iterator // +////////////////////// + +/*! +@brief a template for a reverse iterator class + +@tparam Base the base iterator type to reverse. Valid types are @ref +iterator (to create @ref reverse_iterator) and @ref const_iterator (to +create @ref const_reverse_iterator). + +@requirement The class satisfies the following concept requirements: +- +[BidirectionalIterator](https://en.cppreference.com/w/cpp/named_req/BidirectionalIterator): + The iterator that can be moved can be moved in both directions (i.e. + incremented and decremented). +- [OutputIterator](https://en.cppreference.com/w/cpp/named_req/OutputIterator): + It is possible to write to the pointed-to element (only if @a Base is + @ref iterator). + +@since version 1.0.0 +*/ +template +class json_reverse_iterator : public std::reverse_iterator +{ + public: + using difference_type = std::ptrdiff_t; + /// shortcut to the reverse iterator adapter + using base_iterator = std::reverse_iterator; + /// the reference type for the pointed-to element + using reference = typename Base::reference; + + /// create reverse iterator from iterator + explicit json_reverse_iterator(const typename base_iterator::iterator_type& it) noexcept + : base_iterator(it) {} + + /// create reverse iterator from base class + explicit json_reverse_iterator(const base_iterator& it) noexcept : base_iterator(it) {} + + /// post-increment (it++) + json_reverse_iterator const operator++(int) // NOLINT(readability-const-return-type) + { + return static_cast(base_iterator::operator++(1)); + } + + /// pre-increment (++it) + json_reverse_iterator& operator++() + { + return static_cast(base_iterator::operator++()); + } + + /// post-decrement (it--) + json_reverse_iterator const operator--(int) // NOLINT(readability-const-return-type) + { + return static_cast(base_iterator::operator--(1)); + } + + /// pre-decrement (--it) + json_reverse_iterator& operator--() + { + return static_cast(base_iterator::operator--()); + } + + /// add to iterator + json_reverse_iterator& operator+=(difference_type i) + { + return static_cast(base_iterator::operator+=(i)); + } + + /// add to iterator + json_reverse_iterator operator+(difference_type i) const + { + return static_cast(base_iterator::operator+(i)); + } + + /// subtract from iterator + json_reverse_iterator operator-(difference_type i) const + { + return static_cast(base_iterator::operator-(i)); + } + + /// return difference + difference_type operator-(const json_reverse_iterator& other) const + { + return base_iterator(*this) - base_iterator(other); + } + + /// access to successor + reference operator[](difference_type n) const + { + return *(this->operator+(n)); + } + + /// return the key of an object iterator + auto key() const -> decltype(std::declval().key()) + { + auto it = --this->base(); + return it.key(); + } + + /// return the value of an iterator + reference value() const + { + auto it = --this->base(); + return it.operator * (); + } +}; +} // namespace detail +} // namespace nlohmann + +// #include + +// #include + + +#include // all_of +#include // isdigit +#include // max +#include // accumulate +#include // string +#include // move +#include // vector + +// #include + +// #include + +// #include + +// #include + + +namespace nlohmann +{ + +/// @brief JSON Pointer defines a string syntax for identifying a specific value within a JSON document +/// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/json_pointer/ +template +class json_pointer +{ + // allow basic_json to access private members + NLOHMANN_BASIC_JSON_TPL_DECLARATION + friend class basic_json; + + public: + /// @brief create JSON pointer + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/json_pointer/json_pointer/ + explicit json_pointer(const std::string& s = "") + : reference_tokens(split(s)) + {} + + /// @brief return a string representation of the JSON pointer + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/json_pointer/to_string/ + std::string to_string() const + { + return std::accumulate(reference_tokens.begin(), reference_tokens.end(), + std::string{}, + [](const std::string & a, const std::string & b) + { + return a + "/" + detail::escape(b); + }); + } + + /// @brief return a string representation of the JSON pointer + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/json_pointer/operator_string/ + operator std::string() const + { + return to_string(); + } + + /// @brief append another JSON pointer at the end of this JSON pointer + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/json_pointer/operator_slasheq/ + json_pointer& operator/=(const json_pointer& ptr) + { + reference_tokens.insert(reference_tokens.end(), + ptr.reference_tokens.begin(), + ptr.reference_tokens.end()); + return *this; + } + + /// @brief append an unescaped reference token at the end of this JSON pointer + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/json_pointer/operator_slasheq/ + json_pointer& operator/=(std::string token) + { + push_back(std::move(token)); + return *this; + } + + /// @brief append an array index at the end of this JSON pointer + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/json_pointer/operator_slasheq/ + json_pointer& operator/=(std::size_t array_idx) + { + return *this /= std::to_string(array_idx); + } + + /// @brief create a new JSON pointer by appending the right JSON pointer at the end of the left JSON pointer + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/json_pointer/operator_slash/ + friend json_pointer operator/(const json_pointer& lhs, + const json_pointer& rhs) + { + return json_pointer(lhs) /= rhs; + } + + /// @brief create a new JSON pointer by appending the unescaped token at the end of the JSON pointer + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/json_pointer/operator_slash/ + friend json_pointer operator/(const json_pointer& lhs, std::string token) // NOLINT(performance-unnecessary-value-param) + { + return json_pointer(lhs) /= std::move(token); + } + + /// @brief create a new JSON pointer by appending the array-index-token at the end of the JSON pointer + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/json_pointer/operator_slash/ + friend json_pointer operator/(const json_pointer& lhs, std::size_t array_idx) + { + return json_pointer(lhs) /= array_idx; + } + + /// @brief returns the parent of this JSON pointer + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/json_pointer/parent_pointer/ + json_pointer parent_pointer() const + { + if (empty()) + { + return *this; + } + + json_pointer res = *this; + res.pop_back(); + return res; + } + + /// @brief remove last reference token + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/json_pointer/pop_back/ + void pop_back() + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(empty())) + { + JSON_THROW(detail::out_of_range::create(405, "JSON pointer has no parent", BasicJsonType())); + } + + reference_tokens.pop_back(); + } + + /// @brief return last reference token + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/json_pointer/back/ + const std::string& back() const + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(empty())) + { + JSON_THROW(detail::out_of_range::create(405, "JSON pointer has no parent", BasicJsonType())); + } + + return reference_tokens.back(); + } + + /// @brief append an unescaped token at the end of the reference pointer + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/json_pointer/push_back/ + void push_back(const std::string& token) + { + reference_tokens.push_back(token); + } + + /// @brief append an unescaped token at the end of the reference pointer + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/json_pointer/push_back/ + void push_back(std::string&& token) + { + reference_tokens.push_back(std::move(token)); + } + + /// @brief return whether pointer points to the root document + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/json_pointer/empty/ + bool empty() const noexcept + { + return reference_tokens.empty(); + } + + private: + /*! + @param[in] s reference token to be converted into an array index + + @return integer representation of @a s + + @throw parse_error.106 if an array index begins with '0' + @throw parse_error.109 if an array index begins not with a digit + @throw out_of_range.404 if string @a s could not be converted to an integer + @throw out_of_range.410 if an array index exceeds size_type + */ + static typename BasicJsonType::size_type array_index(const std::string& s) + { + using size_type = typename BasicJsonType::size_type; + + // error condition (cf. RFC 6901, Sect. 4) + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(s.size() > 1 && s[0] == '0')) + { + JSON_THROW(detail::parse_error::create(106, 0, "array index '" + s + "' must not begin with '0'", BasicJsonType())); + } + + // error condition (cf. RFC 6901, Sect. 4) + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(s.size() > 1 && !(s[0] >= '1' && s[0] <= '9'))) + { + JSON_THROW(detail::parse_error::create(109, 0, "array index '" + s + "' is not a number", BasicJsonType())); + } + + std::size_t processed_chars = 0; + unsigned long long res = 0; // NOLINT(runtime/int) + JSON_TRY + { + res = std::stoull(s, &processed_chars); + } + JSON_CATCH(std::out_of_range&) + { + JSON_THROW(detail::out_of_range::create(404, "unresolved reference token '" + s + "'", BasicJsonType())); + } + + // check if the string was completely read + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(processed_chars != s.size())) + { + JSON_THROW(detail::out_of_range::create(404, "unresolved reference token '" + s + "'", BasicJsonType())); + } + + // only triggered on special platforms (like 32bit), see also + // https://github.com/nlohmann/json/pull/2203 + if (res >= static_cast((std::numeric_limits::max)())) // NOLINT(runtime/int) + { + JSON_THROW(detail::out_of_range::create(410, "array index " + s + " exceeds size_type", BasicJsonType())); // LCOV_EXCL_LINE + } + + return static_cast(res); + } + + JSON_PRIVATE_UNLESS_TESTED: + json_pointer top() const + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(empty())) + { + JSON_THROW(detail::out_of_range::create(405, "JSON pointer has no parent", BasicJsonType())); + } + + json_pointer result = *this; + result.reference_tokens = {reference_tokens[0]}; + return result; + } + + private: + /*! + @brief create and return a reference to the pointed to value + + @complexity Linear in the number of reference tokens. + + @throw parse_error.109 if array index is not a number + @throw type_error.313 if value cannot be unflattened + */ + BasicJsonType& get_and_create(BasicJsonType& j) const + { + auto* result = &j; + + // in case no reference tokens exist, return a reference to the JSON value + // j which will be overwritten by a primitive value + for (const auto& reference_token : reference_tokens) + { + switch (result->type()) + { + case detail::value_t::null: + { + if (reference_token == "0") + { + // start a new array if reference token is 0 + result = &result->operator[](0); + } + else + { + // start a new object otherwise + result = &result->operator[](reference_token); + } + break; + } + + case detail::value_t::object: + { + // create an entry in the object + result = &result->operator[](reference_token); + break; + } + + case detail::value_t::array: + { + // create an entry in the array + result = &result->operator[](array_index(reference_token)); + break; + } + + /* + The following code is only reached if there exists a reference + token _and_ the current value is primitive. In this case, we have + an error situation, because primitive values may only occur as + single value; that is, with an empty list of reference tokens. + */ + case detail::value_t::string: + case detail::value_t::boolean: + case detail::value_t::number_integer: + case detail::value_t::number_unsigned: + case detail::value_t::number_float: + case detail::value_t::binary: + case detail::value_t::discarded: + default: + JSON_THROW(detail::type_error::create(313, "invalid value to unflatten", j)); + } + } + + return *result; + } + + /*! + @brief return a reference to the pointed to value + + @note This version does not throw if a value is not present, but tries to + create nested values instead. For instance, calling this function + with pointer `"/this/that"` on a null value is equivalent to calling + `operator[]("this").operator[]("that")` on that value, effectively + changing the null value to an object. + + @param[in] ptr a JSON value + + @return reference to the JSON value pointed to by the JSON pointer + + @complexity Linear in the length of the JSON pointer. + + @throw parse_error.106 if an array index begins with '0' + @throw parse_error.109 if an array index was not a number + @throw out_of_range.404 if the JSON pointer can not be resolved + */ + BasicJsonType& get_unchecked(BasicJsonType* ptr) const + { + for (const auto& reference_token : reference_tokens) + { + // convert null values to arrays or objects before continuing + if (ptr->is_null()) + { + // check if reference token is a number + const bool nums = + std::all_of(reference_token.begin(), reference_token.end(), + [](const unsigned char x) + { + return std::isdigit(x); + }); + + // change value to array for numbers or "-" or to object otherwise + *ptr = (nums || reference_token == "-") + ? detail::value_t::array + : detail::value_t::object; + } + + switch (ptr->type()) + { + case detail::value_t::object: + { + // use unchecked object access + ptr = &ptr->operator[](reference_token); + break; + } + + case detail::value_t::array: + { + if (reference_token == "-") + { + // explicitly treat "-" as index beyond the end + ptr = &ptr->operator[](ptr->m_value.array->size()); + } + else + { + // convert array index to number; unchecked access + ptr = &ptr->operator[](array_index(reference_token)); + } + break; + } + + case detail::value_t::null: + case detail::value_t::string: + case detail::value_t::boolean: + case detail::value_t::number_integer: + case detail::value_t::number_unsigned: + case detail::value_t::number_float: + case detail::value_t::binary: + case detail::value_t::discarded: + default: + JSON_THROW(detail::out_of_range::create(404, "unresolved reference token '" + reference_token + "'", *ptr)); + } + } + + return *ptr; + } + + /*! + @throw parse_error.106 if an array index begins with '0' + @throw parse_error.109 if an array index was not a number + @throw out_of_range.402 if the array index '-' is used + @throw out_of_range.404 if the JSON pointer can not be resolved + */ + BasicJsonType& get_checked(BasicJsonType* ptr) const + { + for (const auto& reference_token : reference_tokens) + { + switch (ptr->type()) + { + case detail::value_t::object: + { + // note: at performs range check + ptr = &ptr->at(reference_token); + break; + } + + case detail::value_t::array: + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(reference_token == "-")) + { + // "-" always fails the range check + JSON_THROW(detail::out_of_range::create(402, + "array index '-' (" + std::to_string(ptr->m_value.array->size()) + + ") is out of range", *ptr)); + } + + // note: at performs range check + ptr = &ptr->at(array_index(reference_token)); + break; + } + + case detail::value_t::null: + case detail::value_t::string: + case detail::value_t::boolean: + case detail::value_t::number_integer: + case detail::value_t::number_unsigned: + case detail::value_t::number_float: + case detail::value_t::binary: + case detail::value_t::discarded: + default: + JSON_THROW(detail::out_of_range::create(404, "unresolved reference token '" + reference_token + "'", *ptr)); + } + } + + return *ptr; + } + + /*! + @brief return a const reference to the pointed to value + + @param[in] ptr a JSON value + + @return const reference to the JSON value pointed to by the JSON + pointer + + @throw parse_error.106 if an array index begins with '0' + @throw parse_error.109 if an array index was not a number + @throw out_of_range.402 if the array index '-' is used + @throw out_of_range.404 if the JSON pointer can not be resolved + */ + const BasicJsonType& get_unchecked(const BasicJsonType* ptr) const + { + for (const auto& reference_token : reference_tokens) + { + switch (ptr->type()) + { + case detail::value_t::object: + { + // use unchecked object access + ptr = &ptr->operator[](reference_token); + break; + } + + case detail::value_t::array: + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(reference_token == "-")) + { + // "-" cannot be used for const access + JSON_THROW(detail::out_of_range::create(402, "array index '-' (" + std::to_string(ptr->m_value.array->size()) + ") is out of range", *ptr)); + } + + // use unchecked array access + ptr = &ptr->operator[](array_index(reference_token)); + break; + } + + case detail::value_t::null: + case detail::value_t::string: + case detail::value_t::boolean: + case detail::value_t::number_integer: + case detail::value_t::number_unsigned: + case detail::value_t::number_float: + case detail::value_t::binary: + case detail::value_t::discarded: + default: + JSON_THROW(detail::out_of_range::create(404, "unresolved reference token '" + reference_token + "'", *ptr)); + } + } + + return *ptr; + } + + /*! + @throw parse_error.106 if an array index begins with '0' + @throw parse_error.109 if an array index was not a number + @throw out_of_range.402 if the array index '-' is used + @throw out_of_range.404 if the JSON pointer can not be resolved + */ + const BasicJsonType& get_checked(const BasicJsonType* ptr) const + { + for (const auto& reference_token : reference_tokens) + { + switch (ptr->type()) + { + case detail::value_t::object: + { + // note: at performs range check + ptr = &ptr->at(reference_token); + break; + } + + case detail::value_t::array: + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(reference_token == "-")) + { + // "-" always fails the range check + JSON_THROW(detail::out_of_range::create(402, + "array index '-' (" + std::to_string(ptr->m_value.array->size()) + + ") is out of range", *ptr)); + } + + // note: at performs range check + ptr = &ptr->at(array_index(reference_token)); + break; + } + + case detail::value_t::null: + case detail::value_t::string: + case detail::value_t::boolean: + case detail::value_t::number_integer: + case detail::value_t::number_unsigned: + case detail::value_t::number_float: + case detail::value_t::binary: + case detail::value_t::discarded: + default: + JSON_THROW(detail::out_of_range::create(404, "unresolved reference token '" + reference_token + "'", *ptr)); + } + } + + return *ptr; + } + + /*! + @throw parse_error.106 if an array index begins with '0' + @throw parse_error.109 if an array index was not a number + */ + bool contains(const BasicJsonType* ptr) const + { + for (const auto& reference_token : reference_tokens) + { + switch (ptr->type()) + { + case detail::value_t::object: + { + if (!ptr->contains(reference_token)) + { + // we did not find the key in the object + return false; + } + + ptr = &ptr->operator[](reference_token); + break; + } + + case detail::value_t::array: + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(reference_token == "-")) + { + // "-" always fails the range check + return false; + } + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(reference_token.size() == 1 && !("0" <= reference_token && reference_token <= "9"))) + { + // invalid char + return false; + } + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(reference_token.size() > 1)) + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!('1' <= reference_token[0] && reference_token[0] <= '9'))) + { + // first char should be between '1' and '9' + return false; + } + for (std::size_t i = 1; i < reference_token.size(); i++) + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!('0' <= reference_token[i] && reference_token[i] <= '9'))) + { + // other char should be between '0' and '9' + return false; + } + } + } + + const auto idx = array_index(reference_token); + if (idx >= ptr->size()) + { + // index out of range + return false; + } + + ptr = &ptr->operator[](idx); + break; + } + + case detail::value_t::null: + case detail::value_t::string: + case detail::value_t::boolean: + case detail::value_t::number_integer: + case detail::value_t::number_unsigned: + case detail::value_t::number_float: + case detail::value_t::binary: + case detail::value_t::discarded: + default: + { + // we do not expect primitive values if there is still a + // reference token to process + return false; + } + } + } + + // no reference token left means we found a primitive value + return true; + } + + /*! + @brief split the string input to reference tokens + + @note This function is only called by the json_pointer constructor. + All exceptions below are documented there. + + @throw parse_error.107 if the pointer is not empty or begins with '/' + @throw parse_error.108 if character '~' is not followed by '0' or '1' + */ + static std::vector split(const std::string& reference_string) + { + std::vector result; + + // special case: empty reference string -> no reference tokens + if (reference_string.empty()) + { + return result; + } + + // check if nonempty reference string begins with slash + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(reference_string[0] != '/')) + { + JSON_THROW(detail::parse_error::create(107, 1, "JSON pointer must be empty or begin with '/' - was: '" + reference_string + "'", BasicJsonType())); + } + + // extract the reference tokens: + // - slash: position of the last read slash (or end of string) + // - start: position after the previous slash + for ( + // search for the first slash after the first character + std::size_t slash = reference_string.find_first_of('/', 1), + // set the beginning of the first reference token + start = 1; + // we can stop if start == 0 (if slash == std::string::npos) + start != 0; + // set the beginning of the next reference token + // (will eventually be 0 if slash == std::string::npos) + start = (slash == std::string::npos) ? 0 : slash + 1, + // find next slash + slash = reference_string.find_first_of('/', start)) + { + // use the text between the beginning of the reference token + // (start) and the last slash (slash). + auto reference_token = reference_string.substr(start, slash - start); + + // check reference tokens are properly escaped + for (std::size_t pos = reference_token.find_first_of('~'); + pos != std::string::npos; + pos = reference_token.find_first_of('~', pos + 1)) + { + JSON_ASSERT(reference_token[pos] == '~'); + + // ~ must be followed by 0 or 1 + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(pos == reference_token.size() - 1 || + (reference_token[pos + 1] != '0' && + reference_token[pos + 1] != '1'))) + { + JSON_THROW(detail::parse_error::create(108, 0, "escape character '~' must be followed with '0' or '1'", BasicJsonType())); + } + } + + // finally, store the reference token + detail::unescape(reference_token); + result.push_back(reference_token); + } + + return result; + } + + private: + /*! + @param[in] reference_string the reference string to the current value + @param[in] value the value to consider + @param[in,out] result the result object to insert values to + + @note Empty objects or arrays are flattened to `null`. + */ + static void flatten(const std::string& reference_string, + const BasicJsonType& value, + BasicJsonType& result) + { + switch (value.type()) + { + case detail::value_t::array: + { + if (value.m_value.array->empty()) + { + // flatten empty array as null + result[reference_string] = nullptr; + } + else + { + // iterate array and use index as reference string + for (std::size_t i = 0; i < value.m_value.array->size(); ++i) + { + flatten(reference_string + "/" + std::to_string(i), + value.m_value.array->operator[](i), result); + } + } + break; + } + + case detail::value_t::object: + { + if (value.m_value.object->empty()) + { + // flatten empty object as null + result[reference_string] = nullptr; + } + else + { + // iterate object and use keys as reference string + for (const auto& element : *value.m_value.object) + { + flatten(reference_string + "/" + detail::escape(element.first), element.second, result); + } + } + break; + } + + case detail::value_t::null: + case detail::value_t::string: + case detail::value_t::boolean: + case detail::value_t::number_integer: + case detail::value_t::number_unsigned: + case detail::value_t::number_float: + case detail::value_t::binary: + case detail::value_t::discarded: + default: + { + // add primitive value with its reference string + result[reference_string] = value; + break; + } + } + } + + /*! + @param[in] value flattened JSON + + @return unflattened JSON + + @throw parse_error.109 if array index is not a number + @throw type_error.314 if value is not an object + @throw type_error.315 if object values are not primitive + @throw type_error.313 if value cannot be unflattened + */ + static BasicJsonType + unflatten(const BasicJsonType& value) + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!value.is_object())) + { + JSON_THROW(detail::type_error::create(314, "only objects can be unflattened", value)); + } + + BasicJsonType result; + + // iterate the JSON object values + for (const auto& element : *value.m_value.object) + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!element.second.is_primitive())) + { + JSON_THROW(detail::type_error::create(315, "values in object must be primitive", element.second)); + } + + // assign value to reference pointed to by JSON pointer; Note that if + // the JSON pointer is "" (i.e., points to the whole value), function + // get_and_create returns a reference to result itself. An assignment + // will then create a primitive value. + json_pointer(element.first).get_and_create(result) = element.second; + } + + return result; + } + + /*! + @brief compares two JSON pointers for equality + + @param[in] lhs JSON pointer to compare + @param[in] rhs JSON pointer to compare + @return whether @a lhs is equal to @a rhs + + @complexity Linear in the length of the JSON pointer + + @exceptionsafety No-throw guarantee: this function never throws exceptions. + */ + friend bool operator==(json_pointer const& lhs, + json_pointer const& rhs) noexcept + { + return lhs.reference_tokens == rhs.reference_tokens; + } + + /*! + @brief compares two JSON pointers for inequality + + @param[in] lhs JSON pointer to compare + @param[in] rhs JSON pointer to compare + @return whether @a lhs is not equal @a rhs + + @complexity Linear in the length of the JSON pointer + + @exceptionsafety No-throw guarantee: this function never throws exceptions. + */ + friend bool operator!=(json_pointer const& lhs, + json_pointer const& rhs) noexcept + { + return !(lhs == rhs); + } + + /// the reference tokens + std::vector reference_tokens; +}; +} // namespace nlohmann + +// #include + + +#include +#include + +// #include + + +namespace nlohmann +{ +namespace detail +{ +template +class json_ref +{ + public: + using value_type = BasicJsonType; + + json_ref(value_type&& value) + : owned_value(std::move(value)) + {} + + json_ref(const value_type& value) + : value_ref(&value) + {} + + json_ref(std::initializer_list init) + : owned_value(init) + {} + + template < + class... Args, + enable_if_t::value, int> = 0 > + json_ref(Args && ... args) + : owned_value(std::forward(args)...) + {} + + // class should be movable only + json_ref(json_ref&&) noexcept = default; + json_ref(const json_ref&) = delete; + json_ref& operator=(const json_ref&) = delete; + json_ref& operator=(json_ref&&) = delete; + ~json_ref() = default; + + value_type moved_or_copied() const + { + if (value_ref == nullptr) + { + return std::move(owned_value); + } + return *value_ref; + } + + value_type const& operator*() const + { + return value_ref ? *value_ref : owned_value; + } + + value_type const* operator->() const + { + return &** this; + } + + private: + mutable value_type owned_value = nullptr; + value_type const* value_ref = nullptr; +}; +} // namespace detail +} // namespace nlohmann + +// #include + +// #include + +// #include + +// #include + +// #include + + +#include // reverse +#include // array +#include // isnan, isinf +#include // uint8_t, uint16_t, uint32_t, uint64_t +#include // memcpy +#include // numeric_limits +#include // string +#include // move + +// #include + +// #include + +// #include + + +#include // copy +#include // size_t +#include // back_inserter +#include // shared_ptr, make_shared +#include // basic_string +#include // vector + +#ifndef JSON_NO_IO + #include // streamsize + #include // basic_ostream +#endif // JSON_NO_IO + +// #include + + +namespace nlohmann +{ +namespace detail +{ +/// abstract output adapter interface +template struct output_adapter_protocol +{ + virtual void write_character(CharType c) = 0; + virtual void write_characters(const CharType* s, std::size_t length) = 0; + virtual ~output_adapter_protocol() = default; + + output_adapter_protocol() = default; + output_adapter_protocol(const output_adapter_protocol&) = default; + output_adapter_protocol(output_adapter_protocol&&) noexcept = default; + output_adapter_protocol& operator=(const output_adapter_protocol&) = default; + output_adapter_protocol& operator=(output_adapter_protocol&&) noexcept = default; +}; + +/// a type to simplify interfaces +template +using output_adapter_t = std::shared_ptr>; + +/// output adapter for byte vectors +template> +class output_vector_adapter : public output_adapter_protocol +{ + public: + explicit output_vector_adapter(std::vector& vec) noexcept + : v(vec) + {} + + void write_character(CharType c) override + { + v.push_back(c); + } + + JSON_HEDLEY_NON_NULL(2) + void write_characters(const CharType* s, std::size_t length) override + { + std::copy(s, s + length, std::back_inserter(v)); + } + + private: + std::vector& v; +}; + +#ifndef JSON_NO_IO +/// output adapter for output streams +template +class output_stream_adapter : public output_adapter_protocol +{ + public: + explicit output_stream_adapter(std::basic_ostream& s) noexcept + : stream(s) + {} + + void write_character(CharType c) override + { + stream.put(c); + } + + JSON_HEDLEY_NON_NULL(2) + void write_characters(const CharType* s, std::size_t length) override + { + stream.write(s, static_cast(length)); + } + + private: + std::basic_ostream& stream; +}; +#endif // JSON_NO_IO + +/// output adapter for basic_string +template> +class output_string_adapter : public output_adapter_protocol +{ + public: + explicit output_string_adapter(StringType& s) noexcept + : str(s) + {} + + void write_character(CharType c) override + { + str.push_back(c); + } + + JSON_HEDLEY_NON_NULL(2) + void write_characters(const CharType* s, std::size_t length) override + { + str.append(s, length); + } + + private: + StringType& str; +}; + +template> +class output_adapter +{ + public: + template> + output_adapter(std::vector& vec) + : oa(std::make_shared>(vec)) {} + +#ifndef JSON_NO_IO + output_adapter(std::basic_ostream& s) + : oa(std::make_shared>(s)) {} +#endif // JSON_NO_IO + + output_adapter(StringType& s) + : oa(std::make_shared>(s)) {} + + operator output_adapter_t() + { + return oa; + } + + private: + output_adapter_t oa = nullptr; +}; +} // namespace detail +} // namespace nlohmann + + +namespace nlohmann +{ +namespace detail +{ +/////////////////// +// binary writer // +/////////////////// + +/*! +@brief serialization to CBOR and MessagePack values +*/ +template +class binary_writer +{ + using string_t = typename BasicJsonType::string_t; + using binary_t = typename BasicJsonType::binary_t; + using number_float_t = typename BasicJsonType::number_float_t; + + public: + /*! + @brief create a binary writer + + @param[in] adapter output adapter to write to + */ + explicit binary_writer(output_adapter_t adapter) : oa(std::move(adapter)) + { + JSON_ASSERT(oa); + } + + /*! + @param[in] j JSON value to serialize + @pre j.type() == value_t::object + */ + void write_bson(const BasicJsonType& j) + { + switch (j.type()) + { + case value_t::object: + { + write_bson_object(*j.m_value.object); + break; + } + + case value_t::null: + case value_t::array: + case value_t::string: + case value_t::boolean: + case value_t::number_integer: + case value_t::number_unsigned: + case value_t::number_float: + case value_t::binary: + case value_t::discarded: + default: + { + JSON_THROW(type_error::create(317, "to serialize to BSON, top-level type must be object, but is " + std::string(j.type_name()), j)); + } + } + } + + /*! + @param[in] j JSON value to serialize + */ + void write_cbor(const BasicJsonType& j) + { + switch (j.type()) + { + case value_t::null: + { + oa->write_character(to_char_type(0xF6)); + break; + } + + case value_t::boolean: + { + oa->write_character(j.m_value.boolean + ? to_char_type(0xF5) + : to_char_type(0xF4)); + break; + } + + case value_t::number_integer: + { + if (j.m_value.number_integer >= 0) + { + // CBOR does not differentiate between positive signed + // integers and unsigned integers. Therefore, we used the + // code from the value_t::number_unsigned case here. + if (j.m_value.number_integer <= 0x17) + { + write_number(static_cast(j.m_value.number_integer)); + } + else if (j.m_value.number_integer <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + oa->write_character(to_char_type(0x18)); + write_number(static_cast(j.m_value.number_integer)); + } + else if (j.m_value.number_integer <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + oa->write_character(to_char_type(0x19)); + write_number(static_cast(j.m_value.number_integer)); + } + else if (j.m_value.number_integer <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + oa->write_character(to_char_type(0x1A)); + write_number(static_cast(j.m_value.number_integer)); + } + else + { + oa->write_character(to_char_type(0x1B)); + write_number(static_cast(j.m_value.number_integer)); + } + } + else + { + // The conversions below encode the sign in the first + // byte, and the value is converted to a positive number. + const auto positive_number = -1 - j.m_value.number_integer; + if (j.m_value.number_integer >= -24) + { + write_number(static_cast(0x20 + positive_number)); + } + else if (positive_number <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + oa->write_character(to_char_type(0x38)); + write_number(static_cast(positive_number)); + } + else if (positive_number <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + oa->write_character(to_char_type(0x39)); + write_number(static_cast(positive_number)); + } + else if (positive_number <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + oa->write_character(to_char_type(0x3A)); + write_number(static_cast(positive_number)); + } + else + { + oa->write_character(to_char_type(0x3B)); + write_number(static_cast(positive_number)); + } + } + break; + } + + case value_t::number_unsigned: + { + if (j.m_value.number_unsigned <= 0x17) + { + write_number(static_cast(j.m_value.number_unsigned)); + } + else if (j.m_value.number_unsigned <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + oa->write_character(to_char_type(0x18)); + write_number(static_cast(j.m_value.number_unsigned)); + } + else if (j.m_value.number_unsigned <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + oa->write_character(to_char_type(0x19)); + write_number(static_cast(j.m_value.number_unsigned)); + } + else if (j.m_value.number_unsigned <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + oa->write_character(to_char_type(0x1A)); + write_number(static_cast(j.m_value.number_unsigned)); + } + else + { + oa->write_character(to_char_type(0x1B)); + write_number(static_cast(j.m_value.number_unsigned)); + } + break; + } + + case value_t::number_float: + { + if (std::isnan(j.m_value.number_float)) + { + // NaN is 0xf97e00 in CBOR + oa->write_character(to_char_type(0xF9)); + oa->write_character(to_char_type(0x7E)); + oa->write_character(to_char_type(0x00)); + } + else if (std::isinf(j.m_value.number_float)) + { + // Infinity is 0xf97c00, -Infinity is 0xf9fc00 + oa->write_character(to_char_type(0xf9)); + oa->write_character(j.m_value.number_float > 0 ? to_char_type(0x7C) : to_char_type(0xFC)); + oa->write_character(to_char_type(0x00)); + } + else + { + write_compact_float(j.m_value.number_float, detail::input_format_t::cbor); + } + break; + } + + case value_t::string: + { + // step 1: write control byte and the string length + const auto N = j.m_value.string->size(); + if (N <= 0x17) + { + write_number(static_cast(0x60 + N)); + } + else if (N <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + oa->write_character(to_char_type(0x78)); + write_number(static_cast(N)); + } + else if (N <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + oa->write_character(to_char_type(0x79)); + write_number(static_cast(N)); + } + else if (N <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + oa->write_character(to_char_type(0x7A)); + write_number(static_cast(N)); + } + // LCOV_EXCL_START + else if (N <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + oa->write_character(to_char_type(0x7B)); + write_number(static_cast(N)); + } + // LCOV_EXCL_STOP + + // step 2: write the string + oa->write_characters( + reinterpret_cast(j.m_value.string->c_str()), + j.m_value.string->size()); + break; + } + + case value_t::array: + { + // step 1: write control byte and the array size + const auto N = j.m_value.array->size(); + if (N <= 0x17) + { + write_number(static_cast(0x80 + N)); + } + else if (N <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + oa->write_character(to_char_type(0x98)); + write_number(static_cast(N)); + } + else if (N <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + oa->write_character(to_char_type(0x99)); + write_number(static_cast(N)); + } + else if (N <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + oa->write_character(to_char_type(0x9A)); + write_number(static_cast(N)); + } + // LCOV_EXCL_START + else if (N <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + oa->write_character(to_char_type(0x9B)); + write_number(static_cast(N)); + } + // LCOV_EXCL_STOP + + // step 2: write each element + for (const auto& el : *j.m_value.array) + { + write_cbor(el); + } + break; + } + + case value_t::binary: + { + if (j.m_value.binary->has_subtype()) + { + if (j.m_value.binary->subtype() <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + write_number(static_cast(0xd8)); + write_number(static_cast(j.m_value.binary->subtype())); + } + else if (j.m_value.binary->subtype() <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + write_number(static_cast(0xd9)); + write_number(static_cast(j.m_value.binary->subtype())); + } + else if (j.m_value.binary->subtype() <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + write_number(static_cast(0xda)); + write_number(static_cast(j.m_value.binary->subtype())); + } + else if (j.m_value.binary->subtype() <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + write_number(static_cast(0xdb)); + write_number(static_cast(j.m_value.binary->subtype())); + } + } + + // step 1: write control byte and the binary array size + const auto N = j.m_value.binary->size(); + if (N <= 0x17) + { + write_number(static_cast(0x40 + N)); + } + else if (N <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + oa->write_character(to_char_type(0x58)); + write_number(static_cast(N)); + } + else if (N <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + oa->write_character(to_char_type(0x59)); + write_number(static_cast(N)); + } + else if (N <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + oa->write_character(to_char_type(0x5A)); + write_number(static_cast(N)); + } + // LCOV_EXCL_START + else if (N <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + oa->write_character(to_char_type(0x5B)); + write_number(static_cast(N)); + } + // LCOV_EXCL_STOP + + // step 2: write each element + oa->write_characters( + reinterpret_cast(j.m_value.binary->data()), + N); + + break; + } + + case value_t::object: + { + // step 1: write control byte and the object size + const auto N = j.m_value.object->size(); + if (N <= 0x17) + { + write_number(static_cast(0xA0 + N)); + } + else if (N <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + oa->write_character(to_char_type(0xB8)); + write_number(static_cast(N)); + } + else if (N <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + oa->write_character(to_char_type(0xB9)); + write_number(static_cast(N)); + } + else if (N <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + oa->write_character(to_char_type(0xBA)); + write_number(static_cast(N)); + } + // LCOV_EXCL_START + else if (N <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + oa->write_character(to_char_type(0xBB)); + write_number(static_cast(N)); + } + // LCOV_EXCL_STOP + + // step 2: write each element + for (const auto& el : *j.m_value.object) + { + write_cbor(el.first); + write_cbor(el.second); + } + break; + } + + case value_t::discarded: + default: + break; + } + } + + /*! + @param[in] j JSON value to serialize + */ + void write_msgpack(const BasicJsonType& j) + { + switch (j.type()) + { + case value_t::null: // nil + { + oa->write_character(to_char_type(0xC0)); + break; + } + + case value_t::boolean: // true and false + { + oa->write_character(j.m_value.boolean + ? to_char_type(0xC3) + : to_char_type(0xC2)); + break; + } + + case value_t::number_integer: + { + if (j.m_value.number_integer >= 0) + { + // MessagePack does not differentiate between positive + // signed integers and unsigned integers. Therefore, we used + // the code from the value_t::number_unsigned case here. + if (j.m_value.number_unsigned < 128) + { + // positive fixnum + write_number(static_cast(j.m_value.number_integer)); + } + else if (j.m_value.number_unsigned <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + // uint 8 + oa->write_character(to_char_type(0xCC)); + write_number(static_cast(j.m_value.number_integer)); + } + else if (j.m_value.number_unsigned <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + // uint 16 + oa->write_character(to_char_type(0xCD)); + write_number(static_cast(j.m_value.number_integer)); + } + else if (j.m_value.number_unsigned <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + // uint 32 + oa->write_character(to_char_type(0xCE)); + write_number(static_cast(j.m_value.number_integer)); + } + else if (j.m_value.number_unsigned <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + // uint 64 + oa->write_character(to_char_type(0xCF)); + write_number(static_cast(j.m_value.number_integer)); + } + } + else + { + if (j.m_value.number_integer >= -32) + { + // negative fixnum + write_number(static_cast(j.m_value.number_integer)); + } + else if (j.m_value.number_integer >= (std::numeric_limits::min)() && + j.m_value.number_integer <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + // int 8 + oa->write_character(to_char_type(0xD0)); + write_number(static_cast(j.m_value.number_integer)); + } + else if (j.m_value.number_integer >= (std::numeric_limits::min)() && + j.m_value.number_integer <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + // int 16 + oa->write_character(to_char_type(0xD1)); + write_number(static_cast(j.m_value.number_integer)); + } + else if (j.m_value.number_integer >= (std::numeric_limits::min)() && + j.m_value.number_integer <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + // int 32 + oa->write_character(to_char_type(0xD2)); + write_number(static_cast(j.m_value.number_integer)); + } + else if (j.m_value.number_integer >= (std::numeric_limits::min)() && + j.m_value.number_integer <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + // int 64 + oa->write_character(to_char_type(0xD3)); + write_number(static_cast(j.m_value.number_integer)); + } + } + break; + } + + case value_t::number_unsigned: + { + if (j.m_value.number_unsigned < 128) + { + // positive fixnum + write_number(static_cast(j.m_value.number_integer)); + } + else if (j.m_value.number_unsigned <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + // uint 8 + oa->write_character(to_char_type(0xCC)); + write_number(static_cast(j.m_value.number_integer)); + } + else if (j.m_value.number_unsigned <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + // uint 16 + oa->write_character(to_char_type(0xCD)); + write_number(static_cast(j.m_value.number_integer)); + } + else if (j.m_value.number_unsigned <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + // uint 32 + oa->write_character(to_char_type(0xCE)); + write_number(static_cast(j.m_value.number_integer)); + } + else if (j.m_value.number_unsigned <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + // uint 64 + oa->write_character(to_char_type(0xCF)); + write_number(static_cast(j.m_value.number_integer)); + } + break; + } + + case value_t::number_float: + { + write_compact_float(j.m_value.number_float, detail::input_format_t::msgpack); + break; + } + + case value_t::string: + { + // step 1: write control byte and the string length + const auto N = j.m_value.string->size(); + if (N <= 31) + { + // fixstr + write_number(static_cast(0xA0 | N)); + } + else if (N <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + // str 8 + oa->write_character(to_char_type(0xD9)); + write_number(static_cast(N)); + } + else if (N <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + // str 16 + oa->write_character(to_char_type(0xDA)); + write_number(static_cast(N)); + } + else if (N <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + // str 32 + oa->write_character(to_char_type(0xDB)); + write_number(static_cast(N)); + } + + // step 2: write the string + oa->write_characters( + reinterpret_cast(j.m_value.string->c_str()), + j.m_value.string->size()); + break; + } + + case value_t::array: + { + // step 1: write control byte and the array size + const auto N = j.m_value.array->size(); + if (N <= 15) + { + // fixarray + write_number(static_cast(0x90 | N)); + } + else if (N <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + // array 16 + oa->write_character(to_char_type(0xDC)); + write_number(static_cast(N)); + } + else if (N <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + // array 32 + oa->write_character(to_char_type(0xDD)); + write_number(static_cast(N)); + } + + // step 2: write each element + for (const auto& el : *j.m_value.array) + { + write_msgpack(el); + } + break; + } + + case value_t::binary: + { + // step 0: determine if the binary type has a set subtype to + // determine whether or not to use the ext or fixext types + const bool use_ext = j.m_value.binary->has_subtype(); + + // step 1: write control byte and the byte string length + const auto N = j.m_value.binary->size(); + if (N <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + std::uint8_t output_type{}; + bool fixed = true; + if (use_ext) + { + switch (N) + { + case 1: + output_type = 0xD4; // fixext 1 + break; + case 2: + output_type = 0xD5; // fixext 2 + break; + case 4: + output_type = 0xD6; // fixext 4 + break; + case 8: + output_type = 0xD7; // fixext 8 + break; + case 16: + output_type = 0xD8; // fixext 16 + break; + default: + output_type = 0xC7; // ext 8 + fixed = false; + break; + } + + } + else + { + output_type = 0xC4; // bin 8 + fixed = false; + } + + oa->write_character(to_char_type(output_type)); + if (!fixed) + { + write_number(static_cast(N)); + } + } + else if (N <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + std::uint8_t output_type = use_ext + ? 0xC8 // ext 16 + : 0xC5; // bin 16 + + oa->write_character(to_char_type(output_type)); + write_number(static_cast(N)); + } + else if (N <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + std::uint8_t output_type = use_ext + ? 0xC9 // ext 32 + : 0xC6; // bin 32 + + oa->write_character(to_char_type(output_type)); + write_number(static_cast(N)); + } + + // step 1.5: if this is an ext type, write the subtype + if (use_ext) + { + write_number(static_cast(j.m_value.binary->subtype())); + } + + // step 2: write the byte string + oa->write_characters( + reinterpret_cast(j.m_value.binary->data()), + N); + + break; + } + + case value_t::object: + { + // step 1: write control byte and the object size + const auto N = j.m_value.object->size(); + if (N <= 15) + { + // fixmap + write_number(static_cast(0x80 | (N & 0xF))); + } + else if (N <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + // map 16 + oa->write_character(to_char_type(0xDE)); + write_number(static_cast(N)); + } + else if (N <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + // map 32 + oa->write_character(to_char_type(0xDF)); + write_number(static_cast(N)); + } + + // step 2: write each element + for (const auto& el : *j.m_value.object) + { + write_msgpack(el.first); + write_msgpack(el.second); + } + break; + } + + case value_t::discarded: + default: + break; + } + } + + /*! + @param[in] j JSON value to serialize + @param[in] use_count whether to use '#' prefixes (optimized format) + @param[in] use_type whether to use '$' prefixes (optimized format) + @param[in] add_prefix whether prefixes need to be used for this value + */ + void write_ubjson(const BasicJsonType& j, const bool use_count, + const bool use_type, const bool add_prefix = true) + { + switch (j.type()) + { + case value_t::null: + { + if (add_prefix) + { + oa->write_character(to_char_type('Z')); + } + break; + } + + case value_t::boolean: + { + if (add_prefix) + { + oa->write_character(j.m_value.boolean + ? to_char_type('T') + : to_char_type('F')); + } + break; + } + + case value_t::number_integer: + { + write_number_with_ubjson_prefix(j.m_value.number_integer, add_prefix); + break; + } + + case value_t::number_unsigned: + { + write_number_with_ubjson_prefix(j.m_value.number_unsigned, add_prefix); + break; + } + + case value_t::number_float: + { + write_number_with_ubjson_prefix(j.m_value.number_float, add_prefix); + break; + } + + case value_t::string: + { + if (add_prefix) + { + oa->write_character(to_char_type('S')); + } + write_number_with_ubjson_prefix(j.m_value.string->size(), true); + oa->write_characters( + reinterpret_cast(j.m_value.string->c_str()), + j.m_value.string->size()); + break; + } + + case value_t::array: + { + if (add_prefix) + { + oa->write_character(to_char_type('[')); + } + + bool prefix_required = true; + if (use_type && !j.m_value.array->empty()) + { + JSON_ASSERT(use_count); + const CharType first_prefix = ubjson_prefix(j.front()); + const bool same_prefix = std::all_of(j.begin() + 1, j.end(), + [this, first_prefix](const BasicJsonType & v) + { + return ubjson_prefix(v) == first_prefix; + }); + + if (same_prefix) + { + prefix_required = false; + oa->write_character(to_char_type('$')); + oa->write_character(first_prefix); + } + } + + if (use_count) + { + oa->write_character(to_char_type('#')); + write_number_with_ubjson_prefix(j.m_value.array->size(), true); + } + + for (const auto& el : *j.m_value.array) + { + write_ubjson(el, use_count, use_type, prefix_required); + } + + if (!use_count) + { + oa->write_character(to_char_type(']')); + } + + break; + } + + case value_t::binary: + { + if (add_prefix) + { + oa->write_character(to_char_type('[')); + } + + if (use_type && !j.m_value.binary->empty()) + { + JSON_ASSERT(use_count); + oa->write_character(to_char_type('$')); + oa->write_character('U'); + } + + if (use_count) + { + oa->write_character(to_char_type('#')); + write_number_with_ubjson_prefix(j.m_value.binary->size(), true); + } + + if (use_type) + { + oa->write_characters( + reinterpret_cast(j.m_value.binary->data()), + j.m_value.binary->size()); + } + else + { + for (size_t i = 0; i < j.m_value.binary->size(); ++i) + { + oa->write_character(to_char_type('U')); + oa->write_character(j.m_value.binary->data()[i]); + } + } + + if (!use_count) + { + oa->write_character(to_char_type(']')); + } + + break; + } + + case value_t::object: + { + if (add_prefix) + { + oa->write_character(to_char_type('{')); + } + + bool prefix_required = true; + if (use_type && !j.m_value.object->empty()) + { + JSON_ASSERT(use_count); + const CharType first_prefix = ubjson_prefix(j.front()); + const bool same_prefix = std::all_of(j.begin(), j.end(), + [this, first_prefix](const BasicJsonType & v) + { + return ubjson_prefix(v) == first_prefix; + }); + + if (same_prefix) + { + prefix_required = false; + oa->write_character(to_char_type('$')); + oa->write_character(first_prefix); + } + } + + if (use_count) + { + oa->write_character(to_char_type('#')); + write_number_with_ubjson_prefix(j.m_value.object->size(), true); + } + + for (const auto& el : *j.m_value.object) + { + write_number_with_ubjson_prefix(el.first.size(), true); + oa->write_characters( + reinterpret_cast(el.first.c_str()), + el.first.size()); + write_ubjson(el.second, use_count, use_type, prefix_required); + } + + if (!use_count) + { + oa->write_character(to_char_type('}')); + } + + break; + } + + case value_t::discarded: + default: + break; + } + } + + private: + ////////// + // BSON // + ////////// + + /*! + @return The size of a BSON document entry header, including the id marker + and the entry name size (and its null-terminator). + */ + static std::size_t calc_bson_entry_header_size(const string_t& name, const BasicJsonType& j) + { + const auto it = name.find(static_cast(0)); + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(it != BasicJsonType::string_t::npos)) + { + JSON_THROW(out_of_range::create(409, "BSON key cannot contain code point U+0000 (at byte " + std::to_string(it) + ")", j)); + static_cast(j); + } + + return /*id*/ 1ul + name.size() + /*zero-terminator*/1u; + } + + /*! + @brief Writes the given @a element_type and @a name to the output adapter + */ + void write_bson_entry_header(const string_t& name, + const std::uint8_t element_type) + { + oa->write_character(to_char_type(element_type)); // boolean + oa->write_characters( + reinterpret_cast(name.c_str()), + name.size() + 1u); + } + + /*! + @brief Writes a BSON element with key @a name and boolean value @a value + */ + void write_bson_boolean(const string_t& name, + const bool value) + { + write_bson_entry_header(name, 0x08); + oa->write_character(value ? to_char_type(0x01) : to_char_type(0x00)); + } + + /*! + @brief Writes a BSON element with key @a name and double value @a value + */ + void write_bson_double(const string_t& name, + const double value) + { + write_bson_entry_header(name, 0x01); + write_number(value); + } + + /*! + @return The size of the BSON-encoded string in @a value + */ + static std::size_t calc_bson_string_size(const string_t& value) + { + return sizeof(std::int32_t) + value.size() + 1ul; + } + + /*! + @brief Writes a BSON element with key @a name and string value @a value + */ + void write_bson_string(const string_t& name, + const string_t& value) + { + write_bson_entry_header(name, 0x02); + + write_number(static_cast(value.size() + 1ul)); + oa->write_characters( + reinterpret_cast(value.c_str()), + value.size() + 1); + } + + /*! + @brief Writes a BSON element with key @a name and null value + */ + void write_bson_null(const string_t& name) + { + write_bson_entry_header(name, 0x0A); + } + + /*! + @return The size of the BSON-encoded integer @a value + */ + static std::size_t calc_bson_integer_size(const std::int64_t value) + { + return (std::numeric_limits::min)() <= value && value <= (std::numeric_limits::max)() + ? sizeof(std::int32_t) + : sizeof(std::int64_t); + } + + /*! + @brief Writes a BSON element with key @a name and integer @a value + */ + void write_bson_integer(const string_t& name, + const std::int64_t value) + { + if ((std::numeric_limits::min)() <= value && value <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + write_bson_entry_header(name, 0x10); // int32 + write_number(static_cast(value)); + } + else + { + write_bson_entry_header(name, 0x12); // int64 + write_number(static_cast(value)); + } + } + + /*! + @return The size of the BSON-encoded unsigned integer in @a j + */ + static constexpr std::size_t calc_bson_unsigned_size(const std::uint64_t value) noexcept + { + return (value <= static_cast((std::numeric_limits::max)())) + ? sizeof(std::int32_t) + : sizeof(std::int64_t); + } + + /*! + @brief Writes a BSON element with key @a name and unsigned @a value + */ + void write_bson_unsigned(const string_t& name, + const BasicJsonType& j) + { + if (j.m_value.number_unsigned <= static_cast((std::numeric_limits::max)())) + { + write_bson_entry_header(name, 0x10 /* int32 */); + write_number(static_cast(j.m_value.number_unsigned)); + } + else if (j.m_value.number_unsigned <= static_cast((std::numeric_limits::max)())) + { + write_bson_entry_header(name, 0x12 /* int64 */); + write_number(static_cast(j.m_value.number_unsigned)); + } + else + { + JSON_THROW(out_of_range::create(407, "integer number " + std::to_string(j.m_value.number_unsigned) + " cannot be represented by BSON as it does not fit int64", j)); + } + } + + /*! + @brief Writes a BSON element with key @a name and object @a value + */ + void write_bson_object_entry(const string_t& name, + const typename BasicJsonType::object_t& value) + { + write_bson_entry_header(name, 0x03); // object + write_bson_object(value); + } + + /*! + @return The size of the BSON-encoded array @a value + */ + static std::size_t calc_bson_array_size(const typename BasicJsonType::array_t& value) + { + std::size_t array_index = 0ul; + + const std::size_t embedded_document_size = std::accumulate(std::begin(value), std::end(value), static_cast(0), [&array_index](std::size_t result, const typename BasicJsonType::array_t::value_type & el) + { + return result + calc_bson_element_size(std::to_string(array_index++), el); + }); + + return sizeof(std::int32_t) + embedded_document_size + 1ul; + } + + /*! + @return The size of the BSON-encoded binary array @a value + */ + static std::size_t calc_bson_binary_size(const typename BasicJsonType::binary_t& value) + { + return sizeof(std::int32_t) + value.size() + 1ul; + } + + /*! + @brief Writes a BSON element with key @a name and array @a value + */ + void write_bson_array(const string_t& name, + const typename BasicJsonType::array_t& value) + { + write_bson_entry_header(name, 0x04); // array + write_number(static_cast(calc_bson_array_size(value))); + + std::size_t array_index = 0ul; + + for (const auto& el : value) + { + write_bson_element(std::to_string(array_index++), el); + } + + oa->write_character(to_char_type(0x00)); + } + + /*! + @brief Writes a BSON element with key @a name and binary value @a value + */ + void write_bson_binary(const string_t& name, + const binary_t& value) + { + write_bson_entry_header(name, 0x05); + + write_number(static_cast(value.size())); + write_number(value.has_subtype() ? static_cast(value.subtype()) : static_cast(0x00)); + + oa->write_characters(reinterpret_cast(value.data()), value.size()); + } + + /*! + @brief Calculates the size necessary to serialize the JSON value @a j with its @a name + @return The calculated size for the BSON document entry for @a j with the given @a name. + */ + static std::size_t calc_bson_element_size(const string_t& name, + const BasicJsonType& j) + { + const auto header_size = calc_bson_entry_header_size(name, j); + switch (j.type()) + { + case value_t::object: + return header_size + calc_bson_object_size(*j.m_value.object); + + case value_t::array: + return header_size + calc_bson_array_size(*j.m_value.array); + + case value_t::binary: + return header_size + calc_bson_binary_size(*j.m_value.binary); + + case value_t::boolean: + return header_size + 1ul; + + case value_t::number_float: + return header_size + 8ul; + + case value_t::number_integer: + return header_size + calc_bson_integer_size(j.m_value.number_integer); + + case value_t::number_unsigned: + return header_size + calc_bson_unsigned_size(j.m_value.number_unsigned); + + case value_t::string: + return header_size + calc_bson_string_size(*j.m_value.string); + + case value_t::null: + return header_size + 0ul; + + // LCOV_EXCL_START + case value_t::discarded: + default: + JSON_ASSERT(false); // NOLINT(cert-dcl03-c,hicpp-static-assert,misc-static-assert) + return 0ul; + // LCOV_EXCL_STOP + } + } + + /*! + @brief Serializes the JSON value @a j to BSON and associates it with the + key @a name. + @param name The name to associate with the JSON entity @a j within the + current BSON document + */ + void write_bson_element(const string_t& name, + const BasicJsonType& j) + { + switch (j.type()) + { + case value_t::object: + return write_bson_object_entry(name, *j.m_value.object); + + case value_t::array: + return write_bson_array(name, *j.m_value.array); + + case value_t::binary: + return write_bson_binary(name, *j.m_value.binary); + + case value_t::boolean: + return write_bson_boolean(name, j.m_value.boolean); + + case value_t::number_float: + return write_bson_double(name, j.m_value.number_float); + + case value_t::number_integer: + return write_bson_integer(name, j.m_value.number_integer); + + case value_t::number_unsigned: + return write_bson_unsigned(name, j); + + case value_t::string: + return write_bson_string(name, *j.m_value.string); + + case value_t::null: + return write_bson_null(name); + + // LCOV_EXCL_START + case value_t::discarded: + default: + JSON_ASSERT(false); // NOLINT(cert-dcl03-c,hicpp-static-assert,misc-static-assert) + return; + // LCOV_EXCL_STOP + } + } + + /*! + @brief Calculates the size of the BSON serialization of the given + JSON-object @a j. + @param[in] value JSON value to serialize + @pre value.type() == value_t::object + */ + static std::size_t calc_bson_object_size(const typename BasicJsonType::object_t& value) + { + std::size_t document_size = std::accumulate(value.begin(), value.end(), static_cast(0), + [](size_t result, const typename BasicJsonType::object_t::value_type & el) + { + return result += calc_bson_element_size(el.first, el.second); + }); + + return sizeof(std::int32_t) + document_size + 1ul; + } + + /*! + @param[in] value JSON value to serialize + @pre value.type() == value_t::object + */ + void write_bson_object(const typename BasicJsonType::object_t& value) + { + write_number(static_cast(calc_bson_object_size(value))); + + for (const auto& el : value) + { + write_bson_element(el.first, el.second); + } + + oa->write_character(to_char_type(0x00)); + } + + ////////// + // CBOR // + ////////// + + static constexpr CharType get_cbor_float_prefix(float /*unused*/) + { + return to_char_type(0xFA); // Single-Precision Float + } + + static constexpr CharType get_cbor_float_prefix(double /*unused*/) + { + return to_char_type(0xFB); // Double-Precision Float + } + + ///////////// + // MsgPack // + ///////////// + + static constexpr CharType get_msgpack_float_prefix(float /*unused*/) + { + return to_char_type(0xCA); // float 32 + } + + static constexpr CharType get_msgpack_float_prefix(double /*unused*/) + { + return to_char_type(0xCB); // float 64 + } + + //////////// + // UBJSON // + //////////// + + // UBJSON: write number (floating point) + template::value, int>::type = 0> + void write_number_with_ubjson_prefix(const NumberType n, + const bool add_prefix) + { + if (add_prefix) + { + oa->write_character(get_ubjson_float_prefix(n)); + } + write_number(n); + } + + // UBJSON: write number (unsigned integer) + template::value, int>::type = 0> + void write_number_with_ubjson_prefix(const NumberType n, + const bool add_prefix) + { + if (n <= static_cast((std::numeric_limits::max)())) + { + if (add_prefix) + { + oa->write_character(to_char_type('i')); // int8 + } + write_number(static_cast(n)); + } + else if (n <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + if (add_prefix) + { + oa->write_character(to_char_type('U')); // uint8 + } + write_number(static_cast(n)); + } + else if (n <= static_cast((std::numeric_limits::max)())) + { + if (add_prefix) + { + oa->write_character(to_char_type('I')); // int16 + } + write_number(static_cast(n)); + } + else if (n <= static_cast((std::numeric_limits::max)())) + { + if (add_prefix) + { + oa->write_character(to_char_type('l')); // int32 + } + write_number(static_cast(n)); + } + else if (n <= static_cast((std::numeric_limits::max)())) + { + if (add_prefix) + { + oa->write_character(to_char_type('L')); // int64 + } + write_number(static_cast(n)); + } + else + { + if (add_prefix) + { + oa->write_character(to_char_type('H')); // high-precision number + } + + const auto number = BasicJsonType(n).dump(); + write_number_with_ubjson_prefix(number.size(), true); + for (std::size_t i = 0; i < number.size(); ++i) + { + oa->write_character(to_char_type(static_cast(number[i]))); + } + } + } + + // UBJSON: write number (signed integer) + template < typename NumberType, typename std::enable_if < + std::is_signed::value&& + !std::is_floating_point::value, int >::type = 0 > + void write_number_with_ubjson_prefix(const NumberType n, + const bool add_prefix) + { + if ((std::numeric_limits::min)() <= n && n <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + if (add_prefix) + { + oa->write_character(to_char_type('i')); // int8 + } + write_number(static_cast(n)); + } + else if (static_cast((std::numeric_limits::min)()) <= n && n <= static_cast((std::numeric_limits::max)())) + { + if (add_prefix) + { + oa->write_character(to_char_type('U')); // uint8 + } + write_number(static_cast(n)); + } + else if ((std::numeric_limits::min)() <= n && n <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + if (add_prefix) + { + oa->write_character(to_char_type('I')); // int16 + } + write_number(static_cast(n)); + } + else if ((std::numeric_limits::min)() <= n && n <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + if (add_prefix) + { + oa->write_character(to_char_type('l')); // int32 + } + write_number(static_cast(n)); + } + else if ((std::numeric_limits::min)() <= n && n <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + if (add_prefix) + { + oa->write_character(to_char_type('L')); // int64 + } + write_number(static_cast(n)); + } + // LCOV_EXCL_START + else + { + if (add_prefix) + { + oa->write_character(to_char_type('H')); // high-precision number + } + + const auto number = BasicJsonType(n).dump(); + write_number_with_ubjson_prefix(number.size(), true); + for (std::size_t i = 0; i < number.size(); ++i) + { + oa->write_character(to_char_type(static_cast(number[i]))); + } + } + // LCOV_EXCL_STOP + } + + /*! + @brief determine the type prefix of container values + */ + CharType ubjson_prefix(const BasicJsonType& j) const noexcept + { + switch (j.type()) + { + case value_t::null: + return 'Z'; + + case value_t::boolean: + return j.m_value.boolean ? 'T' : 'F'; + + case value_t::number_integer: + { + if ((std::numeric_limits::min)() <= j.m_value.number_integer && j.m_value.number_integer <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + return 'i'; + } + if ((std::numeric_limits::min)() <= j.m_value.number_integer && j.m_value.number_integer <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + return 'U'; + } + if ((std::numeric_limits::min)() <= j.m_value.number_integer && j.m_value.number_integer <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + return 'I'; + } + if ((std::numeric_limits::min)() <= j.m_value.number_integer && j.m_value.number_integer <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + return 'l'; + } + if ((std::numeric_limits::min)() <= j.m_value.number_integer && j.m_value.number_integer <= (std::numeric_limits::max)()) + { + return 'L'; + } + // anything else is treated as high-precision number + return 'H'; // LCOV_EXCL_LINE + } + + case value_t::number_unsigned: + { + if (j.m_value.number_unsigned <= static_cast((std::numeric_limits::max)())) + { + return 'i'; + } + if (j.m_value.number_unsigned <= static_cast((std::numeric_limits::max)())) + { + return 'U'; + } + if (j.m_value.number_unsigned <= static_cast((std::numeric_limits::max)())) + { + return 'I'; + } + if (j.m_value.number_unsigned <= static_cast((std::numeric_limits::max)())) + { + return 'l'; + } + if (j.m_value.number_unsigned <= static_cast((std::numeric_limits::max)())) + { + return 'L'; + } + // anything else is treated as high-precision number + return 'H'; // LCOV_EXCL_LINE + } + + case value_t::number_float: + return get_ubjson_float_prefix(j.m_value.number_float); + + case value_t::string: + return 'S'; + + case value_t::array: // fallthrough + case value_t::binary: + return '['; + + case value_t::object: + return '{'; + + case value_t::discarded: + default: // discarded values + return 'N'; + } + } + + static constexpr CharType get_ubjson_float_prefix(float /*unused*/) + { + return 'd'; // float 32 + } + + static constexpr CharType get_ubjson_float_prefix(double /*unused*/) + { + return 'D'; // float 64 + } + + /////////////////////// + // Utility functions // + /////////////////////// + + /* + @brief write a number to output input + @param[in] n number of type @a NumberType + @tparam NumberType the type of the number + @tparam OutputIsLittleEndian Set to true if output data is + required to be little endian + + @note This function needs to respect the system's endianness, because bytes + in CBOR, MessagePack, and UBJSON are stored in network order (big + endian) and therefore need reordering on little endian systems. + */ + template + void write_number(const NumberType n) + { + // step 1: write number to array of length NumberType + std::array vec{}; + std::memcpy(vec.data(), &n, sizeof(NumberType)); + + // step 2: write array to output (with possible reordering) + if (is_little_endian != OutputIsLittleEndian) + { + // reverse byte order prior to conversion if necessary + std::reverse(vec.begin(), vec.end()); + } + + oa->write_characters(vec.data(), sizeof(NumberType)); + } + + void write_compact_float(const number_float_t n, detail::input_format_t format) + { +#ifdef __GNUC__ +#pragma GCC diagnostic push +#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wfloat-equal" +#endif + if (static_cast(n) >= static_cast(std::numeric_limits::lowest()) && + static_cast(n) <= static_cast((std::numeric_limits::max)()) && + static_cast(static_cast(n)) == static_cast(n)) + { + oa->write_character(format == detail::input_format_t::cbor + ? get_cbor_float_prefix(static_cast(n)) + : get_msgpack_float_prefix(static_cast(n))); + write_number(static_cast(n)); + } + else + { + oa->write_character(format == detail::input_format_t::cbor + ? get_cbor_float_prefix(n) + : get_msgpack_float_prefix(n)); + write_number(n); + } +#ifdef __GNUC__ +#pragma GCC diagnostic pop +#endif + } + + public: + // The following to_char_type functions are implement the conversion + // between uint8_t and CharType. In case CharType is not unsigned, + // such a conversion is required to allow values greater than 128. + // See for a discussion. + template < typename C = CharType, + enable_if_t < std::is_signed::value && std::is_signed::value > * = nullptr > + static constexpr CharType to_char_type(std::uint8_t x) noexcept + { + return *reinterpret_cast(&x); + } + + template < typename C = CharType, + enable_if_t < std::is_signed::value && std::is_unsigned::value > * = nullptr > + static CharType to_char_type(std::uint8_t x) noexcept + { + static_assert(sizeof(std::uint8_t) == sizeof(CharType), "size of CharType must be equal to std::uint8_t"); + static_assert(std::is_trivial::value, "CharType must be trivial"); + CharType result; + std::memcpy(&result, &x, sizeof(x)); + return result; + } + + template::value>* = nullptr> + static constexpr CharType to_char_type(std::uint8_t x) noexcept + { + return x; + } + + template < typename InputCharType, typename C = CharType, + enable_if_t < + std::is_signed::value && + std::is_signed::value && + std::is_same::type>::value + > * = nullptr > + static constexpr CharType to_char_type(InputCharType x) noexcept + { + return x; + } + + private: + /// whether we can assume little endianness + const bool is_little_endian = little_endianness(); + + /// the output + output_adapter_t oa = nullptr; +}; +} // namespace detail +} // namespace nlohmann + +// #include + +// #include + + +#include // reverse, remove, fill, find, none_of +#include // array +#include // localeconv, lconv +#include // labs, isfinite, isnan, signbit +#include // size_t, ptrdiff_t +#include // uint8_t +#include // snprintf +#include // numeric_limits +#include // string, char_traits +#include // setfill, setw +#include // is_same +#include // move + +// #include + + +#include // array +#include // signbit, isfinite +#include // intN_t, uintN_t +#include // memcpy, memmove +#include // numeric_limits +#include // conditional + +// #include + + +namespace nlohmann +{ +namespace detail +{ + +/*! +@brief implements the Grisu2 algorithm for binary to decimal floating-point +conversion. + +This implementation is a slightly modified version of the reference +implementation which may be obtained from +http://florian.loitsch.com/publications (bench.tar.gz). + +The code is distributed under the MIT license, Copyright (c) 2009 Florian Loitsch. + +For a detailed description of the algorithm see: + +[1] Loitsch, "Printing Floating-Point Numbers Quickly and Accurately with + Integers", Proceedings of the ACM SIGPLAN 2010 Conference on Programming + Language Design and Implementation, PLDI 2010 +[2] Burger, Dybvig, "Printing Floating-Point Numbers Quickly and Accurately", + Proceedings of the ACM SIGPLAN 1996 Conference on Programming Language + Design and Implementation, PLDI 1996 +*/ +namespace dtoa_impl +{ + +template +Target reinterpret_bits(const Source source) +{ + static_assert(sizeof(Target) == sizeof(Source), "size mismatch"); + + Target target; + std::memcpy(&target, &source, sizeof(Source)); + return target; +} + +struct diyfp // f * 2^e +{ + static constexpr int kPrecision = 64; // = q + + std::uint64_t f = 0; + int e = 0; + + constexpr diyfp(std::uint64_t f_, int e_) noexcept : f(f_), e(e_) {} + + /*! + @brief returns x - y + @pre x.e == y.e and x.f >= y.f + */ + static diyfp sub(const diyfp& x, const diyfp& y) noexcept + { + JSON_ASSERT(x.e == y.e); + JSON_ASSERT(x.f >= y.f); + + return {x.f - y.f, x.e}; + } + + /*! + @brief returns x * y + @note The result is rounded. (Only the upper q bits are returned.) + */ + static diyfp mul(const diyfp& x, const diyfp& y) noexcept + { + static_assert(kPrecision == 64, "internal error"); + + // Computes: + // f = round((x.f * y.f) / 2^q) + // e = x.e + y.e + q + + // Emulate the 64-bit * 64-bit multiplication: + // + // p = u * v + // = (u_lo + 2^32 u_hi) (v_lo + 2^32 v_hi) + // = (u_lo v_lo ) + 2^32 ((u_lo v_hi ) + (u_hi v_lo )) + 2^64 (u_hi v_hi ) + // = (p0 ) + 2^32 ((p1 ) + (p2 )) + 2^64 (p3 ) + // = (p0_lo + 2^32 p0_hi) + 2^32 ((p1_lo + 2^32 p1_hi) + (p2_lo + 2^32 p2_hi)) + 2^64 (p3 ) + // = (p0_lo ) + 2^32 (p0_hi + p1_lo + p2_lo ) + 2^64 (p1_hi + p2_hi + p3) + // = (p0_lo ) + 2^32 (Q ) + 2^64 (H ) + // = (p0_lo ) + 2^32 (Q_lo + 2^32 Q_hi ) + 2^64 (H ) + // + // (Since Q might be larger than 2^32 - 1) + // + // = (p0_lo + 2^32 Q_lo) + 2^64 (Q_hi + H) + // + // (Q_hi + H does not overflow a 64-bit int) + // + // = p_lo + 2^64 p_hi + + const std::uint64_t u_lo = x.f & 0xFFFFFFFFu; + const std::uint64_t u_hi = x.f >> 32u; + const std::uint64_t v_lo = y.f & 0xFFFFFFFFu; + const std::uint64_t v_hi = y.f >> 32u; + + const std::uint64_t p0 = u_lo * v_lo; + const std::uint64_t p1 = u_lo * v_hi; + const std::uint64_t p2 = u_hi * v_lo; + const std::uint64_t p3 = u_hi * v_hi; + + const std::uint64_t p0_hi = p0 >> 32u; + const std::uint64_t p1_lo = p1 & 0xFFFFFFFFu; + const std::uint64_t p1_hi = p1 >> 32u; + const std::uint64_t p2_lo = p2 & 0xFFFFFFFFu; + const std::uint64_t p2_hi = p2 >> 32u; + + std::uint64_t Q = p0_hi + p1_lo + p2_lo; + + // The full product might now be computed as + // + // p_hi = p3 + p2_hi + p1_hi + (Q >> 32) + // p_lo = p0_lo + (Q << 32) + // + // But in this particular case here, the full p_lo is not required. + // Effectively we only need to add the highest bit in p_lo to p_hi (and + // Q_hi + 1 does not overflow). + + Q += std::uint64_t{1} << (64u - 32u - 1u); // round, ties up + + const std::uint64_t h = p3 + p2_hi + p1_hi + (Q >> 32u); + + return {h, x.e + y.e + 64}; + } + + /*! + @brief normalize x such that the significand is >= 2^(q-1) + @pre x.f != 0 + */ + static diyfp normalize(diyfp x) noexcept + { + JSON_ASSERT(x.f != 0); + + while ((x.f >> 63u) == 0) + { + x.f <<= 1u; + x.e--; + } + + return x; + } + + /*! + @brief normalize x such that the result has the exponent E + @pre e >= x.e and the upper e - x.e bits of x.f must be zero. + */ + static diyfp normalize_to(const diyfp& x, const int target_exponent) noexcept + { + const int delta = x.e - target_exponent; + + JSON_ASSERT(delta >= 0); + JSON_ASSERT(((x.f << delta) >> delta) == x.f); + + return {x.f << delta, target_exponent}; + } +}; + +struct boundaries +{ + diyfp w; + diyfp minus; + diyfp plus; +}; + +/*! +Compute the (normalized) diyfp representing the input number 'value' and its +boundaries. + +@pre value must be finite and positive +*/ +template +boundaries compute_boundaries(FloatType value) +{ + JSON_ASSERT(std::isfinite(value)); + JSON_ASSERT(value > 0); + + // Convert the IEEE representation into a diyfp. + // + // If v is denormal: + // value = 0.F * 2^(1 - bias) = ( F) * 2^(1 - bias - (p-1)) + // If v is normalized: + // value = 1.F * 2^(E - bias) = (2^(p-1) + F) * 2^(E - bias - (p-1)) + + static_assert(std::numeric_limits::is_iec559, + "internal error: dtoa_short requires an IEEE-754 floating-point implementation"); + + constexpr int kPrecision = std::numeric_limits::digits; // = p (includes the hidden bit) + constexpr int kBias = std::numeric_limits::max_exponent - 1 + (kPrecision - 1); + constexpr int kMinExp = 1 - kBias; + constexpr std::uint64_t kHiddenBit = std::uint64_t{1} << (kPrecision - 1); // = 2^(p-1) + + using bits_type = typename std::conditional::type; + + const auto bits = static_cast(reinterpret_bits(value)); + const std::uint64_t E = bits >> (kPrecision - 1); + const std::uint64_t F = bits & (kHiddenBit - 1); + + const bool is_denormal = E == 0; + const diyfp v = is_denormal + ? diyfp(F, kMinExp) + : diyfp(F + kHiddenBit, static_cast(E) - kBias); + + // Compute the boundaries m- and m+ of the floating-point value + // v = f * 2^e. + // + // Determine v- and v+, the floating-point predecessor and successor if v, + // respectively. + // + // v- = v - 2^e if f != 2^(p-1) or e == e_min (A) + // = v - 2^(e-1) if f == 2^(p-1) and e > e_min (B) + // + // v+ = v + 2^e + // + // Let m- = (v- + v) / 2 and m+ = (v + v+) / 2. All real numbers _strictly_ + // between m- and m+ round to v, regardless of how the input rounding + // algorithm breaks ties. + // + // ---+-------------+-------------+-------------+-------------+--- (A) + // v- m- v m+ v+ + // + // -----------------+------+------+-------------+-------------+--- (B) + // v- m- v m+ v+ + + const bool lower_boundary_is_closer = F == 0 && E > 1; + const diyfp m_plus = diyfp(2 * v.f + 1, v.e - 1); + const diyfp m_minus = lower_boundary_is_closer + ? diyfp(4 * v.f - 1, v.e - 2) // (B) + : diyfp(2 * v.f - 1, v.e - 1); // (A) + + // Determine the normalized w+ = m+. + const diyfp w_plus = diyfp::normalize(m_plus); + + // Determine w- = m- such that e_(w-) = e_(w+). + const diyfp w_minus = diyfp::normalize_to(m_minus, w_plus.e); + + return {diyfp::normalize(v), w_minus, w_plus}; +} + +// Given normalized diyfp w, Grisu needs to find a (normalized) cached +// power-of-ten c, such that the exponent of the product c * w = f * 2^e lies +// within a certain range [alpha, gamma] (Definition 3.2 from [1]) +// +// alpha <= e = e_c + e_w + q <= gamma +// +// or +// +// f_c * f_w * 2^alpha <= f_c 2^(e_c) * f_w 2^(e_w) * 2^q +// <= f_c * f_w * 2^gamma +// +// Since c and w are normalized, i.e. 2^(q-1) <= f < 2^q, this implies +// +// 2^(q-1) * 2^(q-1) * 2^alpha <= c * w * 2^q < 2^q * 2^q * 2^gamma +// +// or +// +// 2^(q - 2 + alpha) <= c * w < 2^(q + gamma) +// +// The choice of (alpha,gamma) determines the size of the table and the form of +// the digit generation procedure. Using (alpha,gamma)=(-60,-32) works out well +// in practice: +// +// The idea is to cut the number c * w = f * 2^e into two parts, which can be +// processed independently: An integral part p1, and a fractional part p2: +// +// f * 2^e = ( (f div 2^-e) * 2^-e + (f mod 2^-e) ) * 2^e +// = (f div 2^-e) + (f mod 2^-e) * 2^e +// = p1 + p2 * 2^e +// +// The conversion of p1 into decimal form requires a series of divisions and +// modulos by (a power of) 10. These operations are faster for 32-bit than for +// 64-bit integers, so p1 should ideally fit into a 32-bit integer. This can be +// achieved by choosing +// +// -e >= 32 or e <= -32 := gamma +// +// In order to convert the fractional part +// +// p2 * 2^e = p2 / 2^-e = d[-1] / 10^1 + d[-2] / 10^2 + ... +// +// into decimal form, the fraction is repeatedly multiplied by 10 and the digits +// d[-i] are extracted in order: +// +// (10 * p2) div 2^-e = d[-1] +// (10 * p2) mod 2^-e = d[-2] / 10^1 + ... +// +// The multiplication by 10 must not overflow. It is sufficient to choose +// +// 10 * p2 < 16 * p2 = 2^4 * p2 <= 2^64. +// +// Since p2 = f mod 2^-e < 2^-e, +// +// -e <= 60 or e >= -60 := alpha + +constexpr int kAlpha = -60; +constexpr int kGamma = -32; + +struct cached_power // c = f * 2^e ~= 10^k +{ + std::uint64_t f; + int e; + int k; +}; + +/*! +For a normalized diyfp w = f * 2^e, this function returns a (normalized) cached +power-of-ten c = f_c * 2^e_c, such that the exponent of the product w * c +satisfies (Definition 3.2 from [1]) + + alpha <= e_c + e + q <= gamma. +*/ +inline cached_power get_cached_power_for_binary_exponent(int e) +{ + // Now + // + // alpha <= e_c + e + q <= gamma (1) + // ==> f_c * 2^alpha <= c * 2^e * 2^q + // + // and since the c's are normalized, 2^(q-1) <= f_c, + // + // ==> 2^(q - 1 + alpha) <= c * 2^(e + q) + // ==> 2^(alpha - e - 1) <= c + // + // If c were an exact power of ten, i.e. c = 10^k, one may determine k as + // + // k = ceil( log_10( 2^(alpha - e - 1) ) ) + // = ceil( (alpha - e - 1) * log_10(2) ) + // + // From the paper: + // "In theory the result of the procedure could be wrong since c is rounded, + // and the computation itself is approximated [...]. In practice, however, + // this simple function is sufficient." + // + // For IEEE double precision floating-point numbers converted into + // normalized diyfp's w = f * 2^e, with q = 64, + // + // e >= -1022 (min IEEE exponent) + // -52 (p - 1) + // -52 (p - 1, possibly normalize denormal IEEE numbers) + // -11 (normalize the diyfp) + // = -1137 + // + // and + // + // e <= +1023 (max IEEE exponent) + // -52 (p - 1) + // -11 (normalize the diyfp) + // = 960 + // + // This binary exponent range [-1137,960] results in a decimal exponent + // range [-307,324]. One does not need to store a cached power for each + // k in this range. For each such k it suffices to find a cached power + // such that the exponent of the product lies in [alpha,gamma]. + // This implies that the difference of the decimal exponents of adjacent + // table entries must be less than or equal to + // + // floor( (gamma - alpha) * log_10(2) ) = 8. + // + // (A smaller distance gamma-alpha would require a larger table.) + + // NB: + // Actually this function returns c, such that -60 <= e_c + e + 64 <= -34. + + constexpr int kCachedPowersMinDecExp = -300; + constexpr int kCachedPowersDecStep = 8; + + static constexpr std::array kCachedPowers = + { + { + { 0xAB70FE17C79AC6CA, -1060, -300 }, + { 0xFF77B1FCBEBCDC4F, -1034, -292 }, + { 0xBE5691EF416BD60C, -1007, -284 }, + { 0x8DD01FAD907FFC3C, -980, -276 }, + { 0xD3515C2831559A83, -954, -268 }, + { 0x9D71AC8FADA6C9B5, -927, -260 }, + { 0xEA9C227723EE8BCB, -901, -252 }, + { 0xAECC49914078536D, -874, -244 }, + { 0x823C12795DB6CE57, -847, -236 }, + { 0xC21094364DFB5637, -821, -228 }, + { 0x9096EA6F3848984F, -794, -220 }, + { 0xD77485CB25823AC7, -768, -212 }, + { 0xA086CFCD97BF97F4, -741, -204 }, + { 0xEF340A98172AACE5, -715, -196 }, + { 0xB23867FB2A35B28E, -688, -188 }, + { 0x84C8D4DFD2C63F3B, -661, -180 }, + { 0xC5DD44271AD3CDBA, -635, -172 }, + { 0x936B9FCEBB25C996, -608, -164 }, + { 0xDBAC6C247D62A584, -582, -156 }, + { 0xA3AB66580D5FDAF6, -555, -148 }, + { 0xF3E2F893DEC3F126, -529, -140 }, + { 0xB5B5ADA8AAFF80B8, -502, -132 }, + { 0x87625F056C7C4A8B, -475, -124 }, + { 0xC9BCFF6034C13053, -449, -116 }, + { 0x964E858C91BA2655, -422, -108 }, + { 0xDFF9772470297EBD, -396, -100 }, + { 0xA6DFBD9FB8E5B88F, -369, -92 }, + { 0xF8A95FCF88747D94, -343, -84 }, + { 0xB94470938FA89BCF, -316, -76 }, + { 0x8A08F0F8BF0F156B, -289, -68 }, + { 0xCDB02555653131B6, -263, -60 }, + { 0x993FE2C6D07B7FAC, -236, -52 }, + { 0xE45C10C42A2B3B06, -210, -44 }, + { 0xAA242499697392D3, -183, -36 }, + { 0xFD87B5F28300CA0E, -157, -28 }, + { 0xBCE5086492111AEB, -130, -20 }, + { 0x8CBCCC096F5088CC, -103, -12 }, + { 0xD1B71758E219652C, -77, -4 }, + { 0x9C40000000000000, -50, 4 }, + { 0xE8D4A51000000000, -24, 12 }, + { 0xAD78EBC5AC620000, 3, 20 }, + { 0x813F3978F8940984, 30, 28 }, + { 0xC097CE7BC90715B3, 56, 36 }, + { 0x8F7E32CE7BEA5C70, 83, 44 }, + { 0xD5D238A4ABE98068, 109, 52 }, + { 0x9F4F2726179A2245, 136, 60 }, + { 0xED63A231D4C4FB27, 162, 68 }, + { 0xB0DE65388CC8ADA8, 189, 76 }, + { 0x83C7088E1AAB65DB, 216, 84 }, + { 0xC45D1DF942711D9A, 242, 92 }, + { 0x924D692CA61BE758, 269, 100 }, + { 0xDA01EE641A708DEA, 295, 108 }, + { 0xA26DA3999AEF774A, 322, 116 }, + { 0xF209787BB47D6B85, 348, 124 }, + { 0xB454E4A179DD1877, 375, 132 }, + { 0x865B86925B9BC5C2, 402, 140 }, + { 0xC83553C5C8965D3D, 428, 148 }, + { 0x952AB45CFA97A0B3, 455, 156 }, + { 0xDE469FBD99A05FE3, 481, 164 }, + { 0xA59BC234DB398C25, 508, 172 }, + { 0xF6C69A72A3989F5C, 534, 180 }, + { 0xB7DCBF5354E9BECE, 561, 188 }, + { 0x88FCF317F22241E2, 588, 196 }, + { 0xCC20CE9BD35C78A5, 614, 204 }, + { 0x98165AF37B2153DF, 641, 212 }, + { 0xE2A0B5DC971F303A, 667, 220 }, + { 0xA8D9D1535CE3B396, 694, 228 }, + { 0xFB9B7CD9A4A7443C, 720, 236 }, + { 0xBB764C4CA7A44410, 747, 244 }, + { 0x8BAB8EEFB6409C1A, 774, 252 }, + { 0xD01FEF10A657842C, 800, 260 }, + { 0x9B10A4E5E9913129, 827, 268 }, + { 0xE7109BFBA19C0C9D, 853, 276 }, + { 0xAC2820D9623BF429, 880, 284 }, + { 0x80444B5E7AA7CF85, 907, 292 }, + { 0xBF21E44003ACDD2D, 933, 300 }, + { 0x8E679C2F5E44FF8F, 960, 308 }, + { 0xD433179D9C8CB841, 986, 316 }, + { 0x9E19DB92B4E31BA9, 1013, 324 }, + } + }; + + // This computation gives exactly the same results for k as + // k = ceil((kAlpha - e - 1) * 0.30102999566398114) + // for |e| <= 1500, but doesn't require floating-point operations. + // NB: log_10(2) ~= 78913 / 2^18 + JSON_ASSERT(e >= -1500); + JSON_ASSERT(e <= 1500); + const int f = kAlpha - e - 1; + const int k = (f * 78913) / (1 << 18) + static_cast(f > 0); + + const int index = (-kCachedPowersMinDecExp + k + (kCachedPowersDecStep - 1)) / kCachedPowersDecStep; + JSON_ASSERT(index >= 0); + JSON_ASSERT(static_cast(index) < kCachedPowers.size()); + + const cached_power cached = kCachedPowers[static_cast(index)]; + JSON_ASSERT(kAlpha <= cached.e + e + 64); + JSON_ASSERT(kGamma >= cached.e + e + 64); + + return cached; +} + +/*! +For n != 0, returns k, such that pow10 := 10^(k-1) <= n < 10^k. +For n == 0, returns 1 and sets pow10 := 1. +*/ +inline int find_largest_pow10(const std::uint32_t n, std::uint32_t& pow10) +{ + // LCOV_EXCL_START + if (n >= 1000000000) + { + pow10 = 1000000000; + return 10; + } + // LCOV_EXCL_STOP + if (n >= 100000000) + { + pow10 = 100000000; + return 9; + } + if (n >= 10000000) + { + pow10 = 10000000; + return 8; + } + if (n >= 1000000) + { + pow10 = 1000000; + return 7; + } + if (n >= 100000) + { + pow10 = 100000; + return 6; + } + if (n >= 10000) + { + pow10 = 10000; + return 5; + } + if (n >= 1000) + { + pow10 = 1000; + return 4; + } + if (n >= 100) + { + pow10 = 100; + return 3; + } + if (n >= 10) + { + pow10 = 10; + return 2; + } + + pow10 = 1; + return 1; +} + +inline void grisu2_round(char* buf, int len, std::uint64_t dist, std::uint64_t delta, + std::uint64_t rest, std::uint64_t ten_k) +{ + JSON_ASSERT(len >= 1); + JSON_ASSERT(dist <= delta); + JSON_ASSERT(rest <= delta); + JSON_ASSERT(ten_k > 0); + + // <--------------------------- delta ----> + // <---- dist ---------> + // --------------[------------------+-------------------]-------------- + // M- w M+ + // + // ten_k + // <------> + // <---- rest ----> + // --------------[------------------+----+--------------]-------------- + // w V + // = buf * 10^k + // + // ten_k represents a unit-in-the-last-place in the decimal representation + // stored in buf. + // Decrement buf by ten_k while this takes buf closer to w. + + // The tests are written in this order to avoid overflow in unsigned + // integer arithmetic. + + while (rest < dist + && delta - rest >= ten_k + && (rest + ten_k < dist || dist - rest > rest + ten_k - dist)) + { + JSON_ASSERT(buf[len - 1] != '0'); + buf[len - 1]--; + rest += ten_k; + } +} + +/*! +Generates V = buffer * 10^decimal_exponent, such that M- <= V <= M+. +M- and M+ must be normalized and share the same exponent -60 <= e <= -32. +*/ +inline void grisu2_digit_gen(char* buffer, int& length, int& decimal_exponent, + diyfp M_minus, diyfp w, diyfp M_plus) +{ + static_assert(kAlpha >= -60, "internal error"); + static_assert(kGamma <= -32, "internal error"); + + // Generates the digits (and the exponent) of a decimal floating-point + // number V = buffer * 10^decimal_exponent in the range [M-, M+]. The diyfp's + // w, M- and M+ share the same exponent e, which satisfies alpha <= e <= gamma. + // + // <--------------------------- delta ----> + // <---- dist ---------> + // --------------[------------------+-------------------]-------------- + // M- w M+ + // + // Grisu2 generates the digits of M+ from left to right and stops as soon as + // V is in [M-,M+]. + + JSON_ASSERT(M_plus.e >= kAlpha); + JSON_ASSERT(M_plus.e <= kGamma); + + std::uint64_t delta = diyfp::sub(M_plus, M_minus).f; // (significand of (M+ - M-), implicit exponent is e) + std::uint64_t dist = diyfp::sub(M_plus, w ).f; // (significand of (M+ - w ), implicit exponent is e) + + // Split M+ = f * 2^e into two parts p1 and p2 (note: e < 0): + // + // M+ = f * 2^e + // = ((f div 2^-e) * 2^-e + (f mod 2^-e)) * 2^e + // = ((p1 ) * 2^-e + (p2 )) * 2^e + // = p1 + p2 * 2^e + + const diyfp one(std::uint64_t{1} << -M_plus.e, M_plus.e); + + auto p1 = static_cast(M_plus.f >> -one.e); // p1 = f div 2^-e (Since -e >= 32, p1 fits into a 32-bit int.) + std::uint64_t p2 = M_plus.f & (one.f - 1); // p2 = f mod 2^-e + + // 1) + // + // Generate the digits of the integral part p1 = d[n-1]...d[1]d[0] + + JSON_ASSERT(p1 > 0); + + std::uint32_t pow10{}; + const int k = find_largest_pow10(p1, pow10); + + // 10^(k-1) <= p1 < 10^k, pow10 = 10^(k-1) + // + // p1 = (p1 div 10^(k-1)) * 10^(k-1) + (p1 mod 10^(k-1)) + // = (d[k-1] ) * 10^(k-1) + (p1 mod 10^(k-1)) + // + // M+ = p1 + p2 * 2^e + // = d[k-1] * 10^(k-1) + (p1 mod 10^(k-1)) + p2 * 2^e + // = d[k-1] * 10^(k-1) + ((p1 mod 10^(k-1)) * 2^-e + p2) * 2^e + // = d[k-1] * 10^(k-1) + ( rest) * 2^e + // + // Now generate the digits d[n] of p1 from left to right (n = k-1,...,0) + // + // p1 = d[k-1]...d[n] * 10^n + d[n-1]...d[0] + // + // but stop as soon as + // + // rest * 2^e = (d[n-1]...d[0] * 2^-e + p2) * 2^e <= delta * 2^e + + int n = k; + while (n > 0) + { + // Invariants: + // M+ = buffer * 10^n + (p1 + p2 * 2^e) (buffer = 0 for n = k) + // pow10 = 10^(n-1) <= p1 < 10^n + // + const std::uint32_t d = p1 / pow10; // d = p1 div 10^(n-1) + const std::uint32_t r = p1 % pow10; // r = p1 mod 10^(n-1) + // + // M+ = buffer * 10^n + (d * 10^(n-1) + r) + p2 * 2^e + // = (buffer * 10 + d) * 10^(n-1) + (r + p2 * 2^e) + // + JSON_ASSERT(d <= 9); + buffer[length++] = static_cast('0' + d); // buffer := buffer * 10 + d + // + // M+ = buffer * 10^(n-1) + (r + p2 * 2^e) + // + p1 = r; + n--; + // + // M+ = buffer * 10^n + (p1 + p2 * 2^e) + // pow10 = 10^n + // + + // Now check if enough digits have been generated. + // Compute + // + // p1 + p2 * 2^e = (p1 * 2^-e + p2) * 2^e = rest * 2^e + // + // Note: + // Since rest and delta share the same exponent e, it suffices to + // compare the significands. + const std::uint64_t rest = (std::uint64_t{p1} << -one.e) + p2; + if (rest <= delta) + { + // V = buffer * 10^n, with M- <= V <= M+. + + decimal_exponent += n; + + // We may now just stop. But instead look if the buffer could be + // decremented to bring V closer to w. + // + // pow10 = 10^n is now 1 ulp in the decimal representation V. + // The rounding procedure works with diyfp's with an implicit + // exponent of e. + // + // 10^n = (10^n * 2^-e) * 2^e = ulp * 2^e + // + const std::uint64_t ten_n = std::uint64_t{pow10} << -one.e; + grisu2_round(buffer, length, dist, delta, rest, ten_n); + + return; + } + + pow10 /= 10; + // + // pow10 = 10^(n-1) <= p1 < 10^n + // Invariants restored. + } + + // 2) + // + // The digits of the integral part have been generated: + // + // M+ = d[k-1]...d[1]d[0] + p2 * 2^e + // = buffer + p2 * 2^e + // + // Now generate the digits of the fractional part p2 * 2^e. + // + // Note: + // No decimal point is generated: the exponent is adjusted instead. + // + // p2 actually represents the fraction + // + // p2 * 2^e + // = p2 / 2^-e + // = d[-1] / 10^1 + d[-2] / 10^2 + ... + // + // Now generate the digits d[-m] of p1 from left to right (m = 1,2,...) + // + // p2 * 2^e = d[-1]d[-2]...d[-m] * 10^-m + // + 10^-m * (d[-m-1] / 10^1 + d[-m-2] / 10^2 + ...) + // + // using + // + // 10^m * p2 = ((10^m * p2) div 2^-e) * 2^-e + ((10^m * p2) mod 2^-e) + // = ( d) * 2^-e + ( r) + // + // or + // 10^m * p2 * 2^e = d + r * 2^e + // + // i.e. + // + // M+ = buffer + p2 * 2^e + // = buffer + 10^-m * (d + r * 2^e) + // = (buffer * 10^m + d) * 10^-m + 10^-m * r * 2^e + // + // and stop as soon as 10^-m * r * 2^e <= delta * 2^e + + JSON_ASSERT(p2 > delta); + + int m = 0; + for (;;) + { + // Invariant: + // M+ = buffer * 10^-m + 10^-m * (d[-m-1] / 10 + d[-m-2] / 10^2 + ...) * 2^e + // = buffer * 10^-m + 10^-m * (p2 ) * 2^e + // = buffer * 10^-m + 10^-m * (1/10 * (10 * p2) ) * 2^e + // = buffer * 10^-m + 10^-m * (1/10 * ((10*p2 div 2^-e) * 2^-e + (10*p2 mod 2^-e)) * 2^e + // + JSON_ASSERT(p2 <= (std::numeric_limits::max)() / 10); + p2 *= 10; + const std::uint64_t d = p2 >> -one.e; // d = (10 * p2) div 2^-e + const std::uint64_t r = p2 & (one.f - 1); // r = (10 * p2) mod 2^-e + // + // M+ = buffer * 10^-m + 10^-m * (1/10 * (d * 2^-e + r) * 2^e + // = buffer * 10^-m + 10^-m * (1/10 * (d + r * 2^e)) + // = (buffer * 10 + d) * 10^(-m-1) + 10^(-m-1) * r * 2^e + // + JSON_ASSERT(d <= 9); + buffer[length++] = static_cast('0' + d); // buffer := buffer * 10 + d + // + // M+ = buffer * 10^(-m-1) + 10^(-m-1) * r * 2^e + // + p2 = r; + m++; + // + // M+ = buffer * 10^-m + 10^-m * p2 * 2^e + // Invariant restored. + + // Check if enough digits have been generated. + // + // 10^-m * p2 * 2^e <= delta * 2^e + // p2 * 2^e <= 10^m * delta * 2^e + // p2 <= 10^m * delta + delta *= 10; + dist *= 10; + if (p2 <= delta) + { + break; + } + } + + // V = buffer * 10^-m, with M- <= V <= M+. + + decimal_exponent -= m; + + // 1 ulp in the decimal representation is now 10^-m. + // Since delta and dist are now scaled by 10^m, we need to do the + // same with ulp in order to keep the units in sync. + // + // 10^m * 10^-m = 1 = 2^-e * 2^e = ten_m * 2^e + // + const std::uint64_t ten_m = one.f; + grisu2_round(buffer, length, dist, delta, p2, ten_m); + + // By construction this algorithm generates the shortest possible decimal + // number (Loitsch, Theorem 6.2) which rounds back to w. + // For an input number of precision p, at least + // + // N = 1 + ceil(p * log_10(2)) + // + // decimal digits are sufficient to identify all binary floating-point + // numbers (Matula, "In-and-Out conversions"). + // This implies that the algorithm does not produce more than N decimal + // digits. + // + // N = 17 for p = 53 (IEEE double precision) + // N = 9 for p = 24 (IEEE single precision) +} + +/*! +v = buf * 10^decimal_exponent +len is the length of the buffer (number of decimal digits) +The buffer must be large enough, i.e. >= max_digits10. +*/ +JSON_HEDLEY_NON_NULL(1) +inline void grisu2(char* buf, int& len, int& decimal_exponent, + diyfp m_minus, diyfp v, diyfp m_plus) +{ + JSON_ASSERT(m_plus.e == m_minus.e); + JSON_ASSERT(m_plus.e == v.e); + + // --------(-----------------------+-----------------------)-------- (A) + // m- v m+ + // + // --------------------(-----------+-----------------------)-------- (B) + // m- v m+ + // + // First scale v (and m- and m+) such that the exponent is in the range + // [alpha, gamma]. + + const cached_power cached = get_cached_power_for_binary_exponent(m_plus.e); + + const diyfp c_minus_k(cached.f, cached.e); // = c ~= 10^-k + + // The exponent of the products is = v.e + c_minus_k.e + q and is in the range [alpha,gamma] + const diyfp w = diyfp::mul(v, c_minus_k); + const diyfp w_minus = diyfp::mul(m_minus, c_minus_k); + const diyfp w_plus = diyfp::mul(m_plus, c_minus_k); + + // ----(---+---)---------------(---+---)---------------(---+---)---- + // w- w w+ + // = c*m- = c*v = c*m+ + // + // diyfp::mul rounds its result and c_minus_k is approximated too. w, w- and + // w+ are now off by a small amount. + // In fact: + // + // w - v * 10^k < 1 ulp + // + // To account for this inaccuracy, add resp. subtract 1 ulp. + // + // --------+---[---------------(---+---)---------------]---+-------- + // w- M- w M+ w+ + // + // Now any number in [M-, M+] (bounds included) will round to w when input, + // regardless of how the input rounding algorithm breaks ties. + // + // And digit_gen generates the shortest possible such number in [M-, M+]. + // Note that this does not mean that Grisu2 always generates the shortest + // possible number in the interval (m-, m+). + const diyfp M_minus(w_minus.f + 1, w_minus.e); + const diyfp M_plus (w_plus.f - 1, w_plus.e ); + + decimal_exponent = -cached.k; // = -(-k) = k + + grisu2_digit_gen(buf, len, decimal_exponent, M_minus, w, M_plus); +} + +/*! +v = buf * 10^decimal_exponent +len is the length of the buffer (number of decimal digits) +The buffer must be large enough, i.e. >= max_digits10. +*/ +template +JSON_HEDLEY_NON_NULL(1) +void grisu2(char* buf, int& len, int& decimal_exponent, FloatType value) +{ + static_assert(diyfp::kPrecision >= std::numeric_limits::digits + 3, + "internal error: not enough precision"); + + JSON_ASSERT(std::isfinite(value)); + JSON_ASSERT(value > 0); + + // If the neighbors (and boundaries) of 'value' are always computed for double-precision + // numbers, all float's can be recovered using strtod (and strtof). However, the resulting + // decimal representations are not exactly "short". + // + // The documentation for 'std::to_chars' (https://en.cppreference.com/w/cpp/utility/to_chars) + // says "value is converted to a string as if by std::sprintf in the default ("C") locale" + // and since sprintf promotes floats to doubles, I think this is exactly what 'std::to_chars' + // does. + // On the other hand, the documentation for 'std::to_chars' requires that "parsing the + // representation using the corresponding std::from_chars function recovers value exactly". That + // indicates that single precision floating-point numbers should be recovered using + // 'std::strtof'. + // + // NB: If the neighbors are computed for single-precision numbers, there is a single float + // (7.0385307e-26f) which can't be recovered using strtod. The resulting double precision + // value is off by 1 ulp. +#if 0 + const boundaries w = compute_boundaries(static_cast(value)); +#else + const boundaries w = compute_boundaries(value); +#endif + + grisu2(buf, len, decimal_exponent, w.minus, w.w, w.plus); +} + +/*! +@brief appends a decimal representation of e to buf +@return a pointer to the element following the exponent. +@pre -1000 < e < 1000 +*/ +JSON_HEDLEY_NON_NULL(1) +JSON_HEDLEY_RETURNS_NON_NULL +inline char* append_exponent(char* buf, int e) +{ + JSON_ASSERT(e > -1000); + JSON_ASSERT(e < 1000); + + if (e < 0) + { + e = -e; + *buf++ = '-'; + } + else + { + *buf++ = '+'; + } + + auto k = static_cast(e); + if (k < 10) + { + // Always print at least two digits in the exponent. + // This is for compatibility with printf("%g"). + *buf++ = '0'; + *buf++ = static_cast('0' + k); + } + else if (k < 100) + { + *buf++ = static_cast('0' + k / 10); + k %= 10; + *buf++ = static_cast('0' + k); + } + else + { + *buf++ = static_cast('0' + k / 100); + k %= 100; + *buf++ = static_cast('0' + k / 10); + k %= 10; + *buf++ = static_cast('0' + k); + } + + return buf; +} + +/*! +@brief prettify v = buf * 10^decimal_exponent + +If v is in the range [10^min_exp, 10^max_exp) it will be printed in fixed-point +notation. Otherwise it will be printed in exponential notation. + +@pre min_exp < 0 +@pre max_exp > 0 +*/ +JSON_HEDLEY_NON_NULL(1) +JSON_HEDLEY_RETURNS_NON_NULL +inline char* format_buffer(char* buf, int len, int decimal_exponent, + int min_exp, int max_exp) +{ + JSON_ASSERT(min_exp < 0); + JSON_ASSERT(max_exp > 0); + + const int k = len; + const int n = len + decimal_exponent; + + // v = buf * 10^(n-k) + // k is the length of the buffer (number of decimal digits) + // n is the position of the decimal point relative to the start of the buffer. + + if (k <= n && n <= max_exp) + { + // digits[000] + // len <= max_exp + 2 + + std::memset(buf + k, '0', static_cast(n) - static_cast(k)); + // Make it look like a floating-point number (#362, #378) + buf[n + 0] = '.'; + buf[n + 1] = '0'; + return buf + (static_cast(n) + 2); + } + + if (0 < n && n <= max_exp) + { + // dig.its + // len <= max_digits10 + 1 + + JSON_ASSERT(k > n); + + std::memmove(buf + (static_cast(n) + 1), buf + n, static_cast(k) - static_cast(n)); + buf[n] = '.'; + return buf + (static_cast(k) + 1U); + } + + if (min_exp < n && n <= 0) + { + // 0.[000]digits + // len <= 2 + (-min_exp - 1) + max_digits10 + + std::memmove(buf + (2 + static_cast(-n)), buf, static_cast(k)); + buf[0] = '0'; + buf[1] = '.'; + std::memset(buf + 2, '0', static_cast(-n)); + return buf + (2U + static_cast(-n) + static_cast(k)); + } + + if (k == 1) + { + // dE+123 + // len <= 1 + 5 + + buf += 1; + } + else + { + // d.igitsE+123 + // len <= max_digits10 + 1 + 5 + + std::memmove(buf + 2, buf + 1, static_cast(k) - 1); + buf[1] = '.'; + buf += 1 + static_cast(k); + } + + *buf++ = 'e'; + return append_exponent(buf, n - 1); +} + +} // namespace dtoa_impl + +/*! +@brief generates a decimal representation of the floating-point number value in [first, last). + +The format of the resulting decimal representation is similar to printf's %g +format. Returns an iterator pointing past-the-end of the decimal representation. + +@note The input number must be finite, i.e. NaN's and Inf's are not supported. +@note The buffer must be large enough. +@note The result is NOT null-terminated. +*/ +template +JSON_HEDLEY_NON_NULL(1, 2) +JSON_HEDLEY_RETURNS_NON_NULL +char* to_chars(char* first, const char* last, FloatType value) +{ + static_cast(last); // maybe unused - fix warning + JSON_ASSERT(std::isfinite(value)); + + // Use signbit(value) instead of (value < 0) since signbit works for -0. + if (std::signbit(value)) + { + value = -value; + *first++ = '-'; + } + +#ifdef __GNUC__ +#pragma GCC diagnostic push +#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wfloat-equal" +#endif + if (value == 0) // +-0 + { + *first++ = '0'; + // Make it look like a floating-point number (#362, #378) + *first++ = '.'; + *first++ = '0'; + return first; + } +#ifdef __GNUC__ +#pragma GCC diagnostic pop +#endif + + JSON_ASSERT(last - first >= std::numeric_limits::max_digits10); + + // Compute v = buffer * 10^decimal_exponent. + // The decimal digits are stored in the buffer, which needs to be interpreted + // as an unsigned decimal integer. + // len is the length of the buffer, i.e. the number of decimal digits. + int len = 0; + int decimal_exponent = 0; + dtoa_impl::grisu2(first, len, decimal_exponent, value); + + JSON_ASSERT(len <= std::numeric_limits::max_digits10); + + // Format the buffer like printf("%.*g", prec, value) + constexpr int kMinExp = -4; + // Use digits10 here to increase compatibility with version 2. + constexpr int kMaxExp = std::numeric_limits::digits10; + + JSON_ASSERT(last - first >= kMaxExp + 2); + JSON_ASSERT(last - first >= 2 + (-kMinExp - 1) + std::numeric_limits::max_digits10); + JSON_ASSERT(last - first >= std::numeric_limits::max_digits10 + 6); + + return dtoa_impl::format_buffer(first, len, decimal_exponent, kMinExp, kMaxExp); +} + +} // namespace detail +} // namespace nlohmann + +// #include + +// #include + +// #include + +// #include + +// #include + +// #include + + +namespace nlohmann +{ +namespace detail +{ +/////////////////// +// serialization // +/////////////////// + +/// how to treat decoding errors +enum class error_handler_t +{ + strict, ///< throw a type_error exception in case of invalid UTF-8 + replace, ///< replace invalid UTF-8 sequences with U+FFFD + ignore ///< ignore invalid UTF-8 sequences +}; + +template +class serializer +{ + using string_t = typename BasicJsonType::string_t; + using number_float_t = typename BasicJsonType::number_float_t; + using number_integer_t = typename BasicJsonType::number_integer_t; + using number_unsigned_t = typename BasicJsonType::number_unsigned_t; + using binary_char_t = typename BasicJsonType::binary_t::value_type; + static constexpr std::uint8_t UTF8_ACCEPT = 0; + static constexpr std::uint8_t UTF8_REJECT = 1; + + public: + /*! + @param[in] s output stream to serialize to + @param[in] ichar indentation character to use + @param[in] error_handler_ how to react on decoding errors + */ + serializer(output_adapter_t s, const char ichar, + error_handler_t error_handler_ = error_handler_t::strict) + : o(std::move(s)) + , loc(std::localeconv()) + , thousands_sep(loc->thousands_sep == nullptr ? '\0' : std::char_traits::to_char_type(* (loc->thousands_sep))) + , decimal_point(loc->decimal_point == nullptr ? '\0' : std::char_traits::to_char_type(* (loc->decimal_point))) + , indent_char(ichar) + , indent_string(512, indent_char) + , error_handler(error_handler_) + {} + + // delete because of pointer members + serializer(const serializer&) = delete; + serializer& operator=(const serializer&) = delete; + serializer(serializer&&) = delete; + serializer& operator=(serializer&&) = delete; + ~serializer() = default; + + /*! + @brief internal implementation of the serialization function + + This function is called by the public member function dump and organizes + the serialization internally. The indentation level is propagated as + additional parameter. In case of arrays and objects, the function is + called recursively. + + - strings and object keys are escaped using `escape_string()` + - integer numbers are converted implicitly via `operator<<` + - floating-point numbers are converted to a string using `"%g"` format + - binary values are serialized as objects containing the subtype and the + byte array + + @param[in] val value to serialize + @param[in] pretty_print whether the output shall be pretty-printed + @param[in] ensure_ascii If @a ensure_ascii is true, all non-ASCII characters + in the output are escaped with `\uXXXX` sequences, and the result consists + of ASCII characters only. + @param[in] indent_step the indent level + @param[in] current_indent the current indent level (only used internally) + */ + void dump(const BasicJsonType& val, + const bool pretty_print, + const bool ensure_ascii, + const unsigned int indent_step, + const unsigned int current_indent = 0) + { + switch (val.m_type) + { + case value_t::object: + { + if (val.m_value.object->empty()) + { + o->write_characters("{}", 2); + return; + } + + if (pretty_print) + { + o->write_characters("{\n", 2); + + // variable to hold indentation for recursive calls + const auto new_indent = current_indent + indent_step; + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(indent_string.size() < new_indent)) + { + indent_string.resize(indent_string.size() * 2, ' '); + } + + // first n-1 elements + auto i = val.m_value.object->cbegin(); + for (std::size_t cnt = 0; cnt < val.m_value.object->size() - 1; ++cnt, ++i) + { + o->write_characters(indent_string.c_str(), new_indent); + o->write_character('\"'); + dump_escaped(i->first, ensure_ascii); + o->write_characters("\": ", 3); + dump(i->second, true, ensure_ascii, indent_step, new_indent); + o->write_characters(",\n", 2); + } + + // last element + JSON_ASSERT(i != val.m_value.object->cend()); + JSON_ASSERT(std::next(i) == val.m_value.object->cend()); + o->write_characters(indent_string.c_str(), new_indent); + o->write_character('\"'); + dump_escaped(i->first, ensure_ascii); + o->write_characters("\": ", 3); + dump(i->second, true, ensure_ascii, indent_step, new_indent); + + o->write_character('\n'); + o->write_characters(indent_string.c_str(), current_indent); + o->write_character('}'); + } + else + { + o->write_character('{'); + + // first n-1 elements + auto i = val.m_value.object->cbegin(); + for (std::size_t cnt = 0; cnt < val.m_value.object->size() - 1; ++cnt, ++i) + { + o->write_character('\"'); + dump_escaped(i->first, ensure_ascii); + o->write_characters("\":", 2); + dump(i->second, false, ensure_ascii, indent_step, current_indent); + o->write_character(','); + } + + // last element + JSON_ASSERT(i != val.m_value.object->cend()); + JSON_ASSERT(std::next(i) == val.m_value.object->cend()); + o->write_character('\"'); + dump_escaped(i->first, ensure_ascii); + o->write_characters("\":", 2); + dump(i->second, false, ensure_ascii, indent_step, current_indent); + + o->write_character('}'); + } + + return; + } + + case value_t::array: + { + if (val.m_value.array->empty()) + { + o->write_characters("[]", 2); + return; + } + + if (pretty_print) + { + o->write_characters("[\n", 2); + + // variable to hold indentation for recursive calls + const auto new_indent = current_indent + indent_step; + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(indent_string.size() < new_indent)) + { + indent_string.resize(indent_string.size() * 2, ' '); + } + + // first n-1 elements + for (auto i = val.m_value.array->cbegin(); + i != val.m_value.array->cend() - 1; ++i) + { + o->write_characters(indent_string.c_str(), new_indent); + dump(*i, true, ensure_ascii, indent_step, new_indent); + o->write_characters(",\n", 2); + } + + // last element + JSON_ASSERT(!val.m_value.array->empty()); + o->write_characters(indent_string.c_str(), new_indent); + dump(val.m_value.array->back(), true, ensure_ascii, indent_step, new_indent); + + o->write_character('\n'); + o->write_characters(indent_string.c_str(), current_indent); + o->write_character(']'); + } + else + { + o->write_character('['); + + // first n-1 elements + for (auto i = val.m_value.array->cbegin(); + i != val.m_value.array->cend() - 1; ++i) + { + dump(*i, false, ensure_ascii, indent_step, current_indent); + o->write_character(','); + } + + // last element + JSON_ASSERT(!val.m_value.array->empty()); + dump(val.m_value.array->back(), false, ensure_ascii, indent_step, current_indent); + + o->write_character(']'); + } + + return; + } + + case value_t::string: + { + o->write_character('\"'); + dump_escaped(*val.m_value.string, ensure_ascii); + o->write_character('\"'); + return; + } + + case value_t::binary: + { + if (pretty_print) + { + o->write_characters("{\n", 2); + + // variable to hold indentation for recursive calls + const auto new_indent = current_indent + indent_step; + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(indent_string.size() < new_indent)) + { + indent_string.resize(indent_string.size() * 2, ' '); + } + + o->write_characters(indent_string.c_str(), new_indent); + + o->write_characters("\"bytes\": [", 10); + + if (!val.m_value.binary->empty()) + { + for (auto i = val.m_value.binary->cbegin(); + i != val.m_value.binary->cend() - 1; ++i) + { + dump_integer(*i); + o->write_characters(", ", 2); + } + dump_integer(val.m_value.binary->back()); + } + + o->write_characters("],\n", 3); + o->write_characters(indent_string.c_str(), new_indent); + + o->write_characters("\"subtype\": ", 11); + if (val.m_value.binary->has_subtype()) + { + dump_integer(val.m_value.binary->subtype()); + } + else + { + o->write_characters("null", 4); + } + o->write_character('\n'); + o->write_characters(indent_string.c_str(), current_indent); + o->write_character('}'); + } + else + { + o->write_characters("{\"bytes\":[", 10); + + if (!val.m_value.binary->empty()) + { + for (auto i = val.m_value.binary->cbegin(); + i != val.m_value.binary->cend() - 1; ++i) + { + dump_integer(*i); + o->write_character(','); + } + dump_integer(val.m_value.binary->back()); + } + + o->write_characters("],\"subtype\":", 12); + if (val.m_value.binary->has_subtype()) + { + dump_integer(val.m_value.binary->subtype()); + o->write_character('}'); + } + else + { + o->write_characters("null}", 5); + } + } + return; + } + + case value_t::boolean: + { + if (val.m_value.boolean) + { + o->write_characters("true", 4); + } + else + { + o->write_characters("false", 5); + } + return; + } + + case value_t::number_integer: + { + dump_integer(val.m_value.number_integer); + return; + } + + case value_t::number_unsigned: + { + dump_integer(val.m_value.number_unsigned); + return; + } + + case value_t::number_float: + { + dump_float(val.m_value.number_float); + return; + } + + case value_t::discarded: + { + o->write_characters("", 11); + return; + } + + case value_t::null: + { + o->write_characters("null", 4); + return; + } + + default: // LCOV_EXCL_LINE + JSON_ASSERT(false); // NOLINT(cert-dcl03-c,hicpp-static-assert,misc-static-assert) LCOV_EXCL_LINE + } + } + + JSON_PRIVATE_UNLESS_TESTED: + /*! + @brief dump escaped string + + Escape a string by replacing certain special characters by a sequence of an + escape character (backslash) and another character and other control + characters by a sequence of "\u" followed by a four-digit hex + representation. The escaped string is written to output stream @a o. + + @param[in] s the string to escape + @param[in] ensure_ascii whether to escape non-ASCII characters with + \uXXXX sequences + + @complexity Linear in the length of string @a s. + */ + void dump_escaped(const string_t& s, const bool ensure_ascii) + { + std::uint32_t codepoint{}; + std::uint8_t state = UTF8_ACCEPT; + std::size_t bytes = 0; // number of bytes written to string_buffer + + // number of bytes written at the point of the last valid byte + std::size_t bytes_after_last_accept = 0; + std::size_t undumped_chars = 0; + + for (std::size_t i = 0; i < s.size(); ++i) + { + const auto byte = static_cast(s[i]); + + switch (decode(state, codepoint, byte)) + { + case UTF8_ACCEPT: // decode found a new code point + { + switch (codepoint) + { + case 0x08: // backspace + { + string_buffer[bytes++] = '\\'; + string_buffer[bytes++] = 'b'; + break; + } + + case 0x09: // horizontal tab + { + string_buffer[bytes++] = '\\'; + string_buffer[bytes++] = 't'; + break; + } + + case 0x0A: // newline + { + string_buffer[bytes++] = '\\'; + string_buffer[bytes++] = 'n'; + break; + } + + case 0x0C: // formfeed + { + string_buffer[bytes++] = '\\'; + string_buffer[bytes++] = 'f'; + break; + } + + case 0x0D: // carriage return + { + string_buffer[bytes++] = '\\'; + string_buffer[bytes++] = 'r'; + break; + } + + case 0x22: // quotation mark + { + string_buffer[bytes++] = '\\'; + string_buffer[bytes++] = '\"'; + break; + } + + case 0x5C: // reverse solidus + { + string_buffer[bytes++] = '\\'; + string_buffer[bytes++] = '\\'; + break; + } + + default: + { + // escape control characters (0x00..0x1F) or, if + // ensure_ascii parameter is used, non-ASCII characters + if ((codepoint <= 0x1F) || (ensure_ascii && (codepoint >= 0x7F))) + { + if (codepoint <= 0xFFFF) + { + // NOLINTNEXTLINE(cppcoreguidelines-pro-type-vararg,hicpp-vararg) + static_cast((std::snprintf)(string_buffer.data() + bytes, 7, "\\u%04x", + static_cast(codepoint))); + bytes += 6; + } + else + { + // NOLINTNEXTLINE(cppcoreguidelines-pro-type-vararg,hicpp-vararg) + static_cast((std::snprintf)(string_buffer.data() + bytes, 13, "\\u%04x\\u%04x", + static_cast(0xD7C0u + (codepoint >> 10u)), + static_cast(0xDC00u + (codepoint & 0x3FFu)))); + bytes += 12; + } + } + else + { + // copy byte to buffer (all previous bytes + // been copied have in default case above) + string_buffer[bytes++] = s[i]; + } + break; + } + } + + // write buffer and reset index; there must be 13 bytes + // left, as this is the maximal number of bytes to be + // written ("\uxxxx\uxxxx\0") for one code point + if (string_buffer.size() - bytes < 13) + { + o->write_characters(string_buffer.data(), bytes); + bytes = 0; + } + + // remember the byte position of this accept + bytes_after_last_accept = bytes; + undumped_chars = 0; + break; + } + + case UTF8_REJECT: // decode found invalid UTF-8 byte + { + switch (error_handler) + { + case error_handler_t::strict: + { + JSON_THROW(type_error::create(316, "invalid UTF-8 byte at index " + std::to_string(i) + ": 0x" + hex_bytes(byte | 0), BasicJsonType())); + } + + case error_handler_t::ignore: + case error_handler_t::replace: + { + // in case we saw this character the first time, we + // would like to read it again, because the byte + // may be OK for itself, but just not OK for the + // previous sequence + if (undumped_chars > 0) + { + --i; + } + + // reset length buffer to the last accepted index; + // thus removing/ignoring the invalid characters + bytes = bytes_after_last_accept; + + if (error_handler == error_handler_t::replace) + { + // add a replacement character + if (ensure_ascii) + { + string_buffer[bytes++] = '\\'; + string_buffer[bytes++] = 'u'; + string_buffer[bytes++] = 'f'; + string_buffer[bytes++] = 'f'; + string_buffer[bytes++] = 'f'; + string_buffer[bytes++] = 'd'; + } + else + { + string_buffer[bytes++] = detail::binary_writer::to_char_type('\xEF'); + string_buffer[bytes++] = detail::binary_writer::to_char_type('\xBF'); + string_buffer[bytes++] = detail::binary_writer::to_char_type('\xBD'); + } + + // write buffer and reset index; there must be 13 bytes + // left, as this is the maximal number of bytes to be + // written ("\uxxxx\uxxxx\0") for one code point + if (string_buffer.size() - bytes < 13) + { + o->write_characters(string_buffer.data(), bytes); + bytes = 0; + } + + bytes_after_last_accept = bytes; + } + + undumped_chars = 0; + + // continue processing the string + state = UTF8_ACCEPT; + break; + } + + default: // LCOV_EXCL_LINE + JSON_ASSERT(false); // NOLINT(cert-dcl03-c,hicpp-static-assert,misc-static-assert) LCOV_EXCL_LINE + } + break; + } + + default: // decode found yet incomplete multi-byte code point + { + if (!ensure_ascii) + { + // code point will not be escaped - copy byte to buffer + string_buffer[bytes++] = s[i]; + } + ++undumped_chars; + break; + } + } + } + + // we finished processing the string + if (JSON_HEDLEY_LIKELY(state == UTF8_ACCEPT)) + { + // write buffer + if (bytes > 0) + { + o->write_characters(string_buffer.data(), bytes); + } + } + else + { + // we finish reading, but do not accept: string was incomplete + switch (error_handler) + { + case error_handler_t::strict: + { + JSON_THROW(type_error::create(316, "incomplete UTF-8 string; last byte: 0x" + hex_bytes(static_cast(s.back() | 0)), BasicJsonType())); + } + + case error_handler_t::ignore: + { + // write all accepted bytes + o->write_characters(string_buffer.data(), bytes_after_last_accept); + break; + } + + case error_handler_t::replace: + { + // write all accepted bytes + o->write_characters(string_buffer.data(), bytes_after_last_accept); + // add a replacement character + if (ensure_ascii) + { + o->write_characters("\\ufffd", 6); + } + else + { + o->write_characters("\xEF\xBF\xBD", 3); + } + break; + } + + default: // LCOV_EXCL_LINE + JSON_ASSERT(false); // NOLINT(cert-dcl03-c,hicpp-static-assert,misc-static-assert) LCOV_EXCL_LINE + } + } + } + + private: + /*! + @brief count digits + + Count the number of decimal (base 10) digits for an input unsigned integer. + + @param[in] x unsigned integer number to count its digits + @return number of decimal digits + */ + inline unsigned int count_digits(number_unsigned_t x) noexcept + { + unsigned int n_digits = 1; + for (;;) + { + if (x < 10) + { + return n_digits; + } + if (x < 100) + { + return n_digits + 1; + } + if (x < 1000) + { + return n_digits + 2; + } + if (x < 10000) + { + return n_digits + 3; + } + x = x / 10000u; + n_digits += 4; + } + } + + /*! + * @brief convert a byte to a uppercase hex representation + * @param[in] byte byte to represent + * @return representation ("00".."FF") + */ + static std::string hex_bytes(std::uint8_t byte) + { + std::string result = "FF"; + constexpr const char* nibble_to_hex = "0123456789ABCDEF"; + result[0] = nibble_to_hex[byte / 16]; + result[1] = nibble_to_hex[byte % 16]; + return result; + } + + // templates to avoid warnings about useless casts + template ::value, int> = 0> + bool is_negative_number(NumberType x) + { + return x < 0; + } + + template < typename NumberType, enable_if_t ::value, int > = 0 > + bool is_negative_number(NumberType /*unused*/) + { + return false; + } + + /*! + @brief dump an integer + + Dump a given integer to output stream @a o. Works internally with + @a number_buffer. + + @param[in] x integer number (signed or unsigned) to dump + @tparam NumberType either @a number_integer_t or @a number_unsigned_t + */ + template < typename NumberType, detail::enable_if_t < + std::is_integral::value || + std::is_same::value || + std::is_same::value || + std::is_same::value, + int > = 0 > + void dump_integer(NumberType x) + { + static constexpr std::array, 100> digits_to_99 + { + { + {{'0', '0'}}, {{'0', '1'}}, {{'0', '2'}}, {{'0', '3'}}, {{'0', '4'}}, {{'0', '5'}}, {{'0', '6'}}, {{'0', '7'}}, {{'0', '8'}}, {{'0', '9'}}, + {{'1', '0'}}, {{'1', '1'}}, {{'1', '2'}}, {{'1', '3'}}, {{'1', '4'}}, {{'1', '5'}}, {{'1', '6'}}, {{'1', '7'}}, {{'1', '8'}}, {{'1', '9'}}, + {{'2', '0'}}, {{'2', '1'}}, {{'2', '2'}}, {{'2', '3'}}, {{'2', '4'}}, {{'2', '5'}}, {{'2', '6'}}, {{'2', '7'}}, {{'2', '8'}}, {{'2', '9'}}, + {{'3', '0'}}, {{'3', '1'}}, {{'3', '2'}}, {{'3', '3'}}, {{'3', '4'}}, {{'3', '5'}}, {{'3', '6'}}, {{'3', '7'}}, {{'3', '8'}}, {{'3', '9'}}, + {{'4', '0'}}, {{'4', '1'}}, {{'4', '2'}}, {{'4', '3'}}, {{'4', '4'}}, {{'4', '5'}}, {{'4', '6'}}, {{'4', '7'}}, {{'4', '8'}}, {{'4', '9'}}, + {{'5', '0'}}, {{'5', '1'}}, {{'5', '2'}}, {{'5', '3'}}, {{'5', '4'}}, {{'5', '5'}}, {{'5', '6'}}, {{'5', '7'}}, {{'5', '8'}}, {{'5', '9'}}, + {{'6', '0'}}, {{'6', '1'}}, {{'6', '2'}}, {{'6', '3'}}, {{'6', '4'}}, {{'6', '5'}}, {{'6', '6'}}, {{'6', '7'}}, {{'6', '8'}}, {{'6', '9'}}, + {{'7', '0'}}, {{'7', '1'}}, {{'7', '2'}}, {{'7', '3'}}, {{'7', '4'}}, {{'7', '5'}}, {{'7', '6'}}, {{'7', '7'}}, {{'7', '8'}}, {{'7', '9'}}, + {{'8', '0'}}, {{'8', '1'}}, {{'8', '2'}}, {{'8', '3'}}, {{'8', '4'}}, {{'8', '5'}}, {{'8', '6'}}, {{'8', '7'}}, {{'8', '8'}}, {{'8', '9'}}, + {{'9', '0'}}, {{'9', '1'}}, {{'9', '2'}}, {{'9', '3'}}, {{'9', '4'}}, {{'9', '5'}}, {{'9', '6'}}, {{'9', '7'}}, {{'9', '8'}}, {{'9', '9'}}, + } + }; + + // special case for "0" + if (x == 0) + { + o->write_character('0'); + return; + } + + // use a pointer to fill the buffer + auto buffer_ptr = number_buffer.begin(); // NOLINT(llvm-qualified-auto,readability-qualified-auto,cppcoreguidelines-pro-type-vararg,hicpp-vararg) + + number_unsigned_t abs_value; + + unsigned int n_chars{}; + + if (is_negative_number(x)) + { + *buffer_ptr = '-'; + abs_value = remove_sign(static_cast(x)); + + // account one more byte for the minus sign + n_chars = 1 + count_digits(abs_value); + } + else + { + abs_value = static_cast(x); + n_chars = count_digits(abs_value); + } + + // spare 1 byte for '\0' + JSON_ASSERT(n_chars < number_buffer.size() - 1); + + // jump to the end to generate the string from backward, + // so we later avoid reversing the result + buffer_ptr += n_chars; + + // Fast int2ascii implementation inspired by "Fastware" talk by Andrei Alexandrescu + // See: https://www.youtube.com/watch?v=o4-CwDo2zpg + while (abs_value >= 100) + { + const auto digits_index = static_cast((abs_value % 100)); + abs_value /= 100; + *(--buffer_ptr) = digits_to_99[digits_index][1]; + *(--buffer_ptr) = digits_to_99[digits_index][0]; + } + + if (abs_value >= 10) + { + const auto digits_index = static_cast(abs_value); + *(--buffer_ptr) = digits_to_99[digits_index][1]; + *(--buffer_ptr) = digits_to_99[digits_index][0]; + } + else + { + *(--buffer_ptr) = static_cast('0' + abs_value); + } + + o->write_characters(number_buffer.data(), n_chars); + } + + /*! + @brief dump a floating-point number + + Dump a given floating-point number to output stream @a o. Works internally + with @a number_buffer. + + @param[in] x floating-point number to dump + */ + void dump_float(number_float_t x) + { + // NaN / inf + if (!std::isfinite(x)) + { + o->write_characters("null", 4); + return; + } + + // If number_float_t is an IEEE-754 single or double precision number, + // use the Grisu2 algorithm to produce short numbers which are + // guaranteed to round-trip, using strtof and strtod, resp. + // + // NB: The test below works if == . + static constexpr bool is_ieee_single_or_double + = (std::numeric_limits::is_iec559 && std::numeric_limits::digits == 24 && std::numeric_limits::max_exponent == 128) || + (std::numeric_limits::is_iec559 && std::numeric_limits::digits == 53 && std::numeric_limits::max_exponent == 1024); + + dump_float(x, std::integral_constant()); + } + + void dump_float(number_float_t x, std::true_type /*is_ieee_single_or_double*/) + { + auto* begin = number_buffer.data(); + auto* end = ::nlohmann::detail::to_chars(begin, begin + number_buffer.size(), x); + + o->write_characters(begin, static_cast(end - begin)); + } + + void dump_float(number_float_t x, std::false_type /*is_ieee_single_or_double*/) + { + // get number of digits for a float -> text -> float round-trip + static constexpr auto d = std::numeric_limits::max_digits10; + + // the actual conversion + // NOLINTNEXTLINE(cppcoreguidelines-pro-type-vararg,hicpp-vararg) + std::ptrdiff_t len = (std::snprintf)(number_buffer.data(), number_buffer.size(), "%.*g", d, x); + + // negative value indicates an error + JSON_ASSERT(len > 0); + // check if buffer was large enough + JSON_ASSERT(static_cast(len) < number_buffer.size()); + + // erase thousands separator + if (thousands_sep != '\0') + { + // NOLINTNEXTLINE(readability-qualified-auto,llvm-qualified-auto): std::remove returns an iterator, see https://github.com/nlohmann/json/issues/3081 + const auto end = std::remove(number_buffer.begin(), number_buffer.begin() + len, thousands_sep); + std::fill(end, number_buffer.end(), '\0'); + JSON_ASSERT((end - number_buffer.begin()) <= len); + len = (end - number_buffer.begin()); + } + + // convert decimal point to '.' + if (decimal_point != '\0' && decimal_point != '.') + { + // NOLINTNEXTLINE(readability-qualified-auto,llvm-qualified-auto): std::find returns an iterator, see https://github.com/nlohmann/json/issues/3081 + const auto dec_pos = std::find(number_buffer.begin(), number_buffer.end(), decimal_point); + if (dec_pos != number_buffer.end()) + { + *dec_pos = '.'; + } + } + + o->write_characters(number_buffer.data(), static_cast(len)); + + // determine if we need to append ".0" + const bool value_is_int_like = + std::none_of(number_buffer.begin(), number_buffer.begin() + len + 1, + [](char c) + { + return c == '.' || c == 'e'; + }); + + if (value_is_int_like) + { + o->write_characters(".0", 2); + } + } + + /*! + @brief check whether a string is UTF-8 encoded + + The function checks each byte of a string whether it is UTF-8 encoded. The + result of the check is stored in the @a state parameter. The function must + be called initially with state 0 (accept). State 1 means the string must + be rejected, because the current byte is not allowed. If the string is + completely processed, but the state is non-zero, the string ended + prematurely; that is, the last byte indicated more bytes should have + followed. + + @param[in,out] state the state of the decoding + @param[in,out] codep codepoint (valid only if resulting state is UTF8_ACCEPT) + @param[in] byte next byte to decode + @return new state + + @note The function has been edited: a std::array is used. + + @copyright Copyright (c) 2008-2009 Bjoern Hoehrmann + @sa http://bjoern.hoehrmann.de/utf-8/decoder/dfa/ + */ + static std::uint8_t decode(std::uint8_t& state, std::uint32_t& codep, const std::uint8_t byte) noexcept + { + static const std::array utf8d = + { + { + 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, // 00..1F + 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, // 20..3F + 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, // 40..5F + 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, // 60..7F + 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 9, 9, 9, 9, 9, 9, 9, 9, 9, 9, 9, 9, 9, 9, 9, 9, // 80..9F + 7, 7, 7, 7, 7, 7, 7, 7, 7, 7, 7, 7, 7, 7, 7, 7, 7, 7, 7, 7, 7, 7, 7, 7, 7, 7, 7, 7, 7, 7, 7, 7, // A0..BF + 8, 8, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, // C0..DF + 0xA, 0x3, 0x3, 0x3, 0x3, 0x3, 0x3, 0x3, 0x3, 0x3, 0x3, 0x3, 0x3, 0x4, 0x3, 0x3, // E0..EF + 0xB, 0x6, 0x6, 0x6, 0x5, 0x8, 0x8, 0x8, 0x8, 0x8, 0x8, 0x8, 0x8, 0x8, 0x8, 0x8, // F0..FF + 0x0, 0x1, 0x2, 0x3, 0x5, 0x8, 0x7, 0x1, 0x1, 0x1, 0x4, 0x6, 0x1, 0x1, 0x1, 0x1, // s0..s0 + 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 0, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 0, 1, 0, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, // s1..s2 + 1, 2, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 2, 1, 2, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 2, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, // s3..s4 + 1, 2, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 2, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 3, 1, 3, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, // s5..s6 + 1, 3, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 3, 1, 3, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 3, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1 // s7..s8 + } + }; + + JSON_ASSERT(byte < utf8d.size()); + const std::uint8_t type = utf8d[byte]; + + codep = (state != UTF8_ACCEPT) + ? (byte & 0x3fu) | (codep << 6u) + : (0xFFu >> type) & (byte); + + std::size_t index = 256u + static_cast(state) * 16u + static_cast(type); + JSON_ASSERT(index < 400); + state = utf8d[index]; + return state; + } + + /* + * Overload to make the compiler happy while it is instantiating + * dump_integer for number_unsigned_t. + * Must never be called. + */ + number_unsigned_t remove_sign(number_unsigned_t x) + { + JSON_ASSERT(false); // NOLINT(cert-dcl03-c,hicpp-static-assert,misc-static-assert) LCOV_EXCL_LINE + return x; // LCOV_EXCL_LINE + } + + /* + * Helper function for dump_integer + * + * This function takes a negative signed integer and returns its absolute + * value as unsigned integer. The plus/minus shuffling is necessary as we can + * not directly remove the sign of an arbitrary signed integer as the + * absolute values of INT_MIN and INT_MAX are usually not the same. See + * #1708 for details. + */ + inline number_unsigned_t remove_sign(number_integer_t x) noexcept + { + JSON_ASSERT(x < 0 && x < (std::numeric_limits::max)()); // NOLINT(misc-redundant-expression) + return static_cast(-(x + 1)) + 1; + } + + private: + /// the output of the serializer + output_adapter_t o = nullptr; + + /// a (hopefully) large enough character buffer + std::array number_buffer{{}}; + + /// the locale + const std::lconv* loc = nullptr; + /// the locale's thousand separator character + const char thousands_sep = '\0'; + /// the locale's decimal point character + const char decimal_point = '\0'; + + /// string buffer + std::array string_buffer{{}}; + + /// the indentation character + const char indent_char; + /// the indentation string + string_t indent_string; + + /// error_handler how to react on decoding errors + const error_handler_t error_handler; +}; +} // namespace detail +} // namespace nlohmann + +// #include + +// #include + +// #include + + +#include // less +#include // initializer_list +#include // input_iterator_tag, iterator_traits +#include // allocator +#include // for out_of_range +#include // enable_if, is_convertible +#include // pair +#include // vector + +// #include + + +namespace nlohmann +{ + +/// ordered_map: a minimal map-like container that preserves insertion order +/// for use within nlohmann::basic_json +template , + class Allocator = std::allocator>> + struct ordered_map : std::vector, Allocator> +{ + using key_type = Key; + using mapped_type = T; + using Container = std::vector, Allocator>; + using iterator = typename Container::iterator; + using const_iterator = typename Container::const_iterator; + using size_type = typename Container::size_type; + using value_type = typename Container::value_type; + + // Explicit constructors instead of `using Container::Container` + // otherwise older compilers choke on it (GCC <= 5.5, xcode <= 9.4) + ordered_map(const Allocator& alloc = Allocator()) : Container{alloc} {} + template + ordered_map(It first, It last, const Allocator& alloc = Allocator()) + : Container{first, last, alloc} {} + ordered_map(std::initializer_list init, const Allocator& alloc = Allocator() ) + : Container{init, alloc} {} + + std::pair emplace(const key_type& key, T&& t) + { + for (auto it = this->begin(); it != this->end(); ++it) + { + if (it->first == key) + { + return {it, false}; + } + } + Container::emplace_back(key, t); + return {--this->end(), true}; + } + + T& operator[](const Key& key) + { + return emplace(key, T{}).first->second; + } + + const T& operator[](const Key& key) const + { + return at(key); + } + + T& at(const Key& key) + { + for (auto it = this->begin(); it != this->end(); ++it) + { + if (it->first == key) + { + return it->second; + } + } + + JSON_THROW(std::out_of_range("key not found")); + } + + const T& at(const Key& key) const + { + for (auto it = this->begin(); it != this->end(); ++it) + { + if (it->first == key) + { + return it->second; + } + } + + JSON_THROW(std::out_of_range("key not found")); + } + + size_type erase(const Key& key) + { + for (auto it = this->begin(); it != this->end(); ++it) + { + if (it->first == key) + { + // Since we cannot move const Keys, re-construct them in place + for (auto next = it; ++next != this->end(); ++it) + { + it->~value_type(); // Destroy but keep allocation + new (&*it) value_type{std::move(*next)}; + } + Container::pop_back(); + return 1; + } + } + return 0; + } + + iterator erase(iterator pos) + { + return erase(pos, std::next(pos)); + } + + iterator erase(iterator first, iterator last) + { + const auto elements_affected = std::distance(first, last); + const auto offset = std::distance(Container::begin(), first); + + // This is the start situation. We need to delete elements_affected + // elements (3 in this example: e, f, g), and need to return an + // iterator past the last deleted element (h in this example). + // Note that offset is the distance from the start of the vector + // to first. We will need this later. + + // [ a, b, c, d, e, f, g, h, i, j ] + // ^ ^ + // first last + + // Since we cannot move const Keys, we re-construct them in place. + // We start at first and re-construct (viz. copy) the elements from + // the back of the vector. Example for first iteration: + + // ,--------. + // v | destroy e and re-construct with h + // [ a, b, c, d, e, f, g, h, i, j ] + // ^ ^ + // it it + elements_affected + + for (auto it = first; std::next(it, elements_affected) != Container::end(); ++it) + { + it->~value_type(); // destroy but keep allocation + new (&*it) value_type{std::move(*std::next(it, elements_affected))}; // "move" next element to it + } + + // [ a, b, c, d, h, i, j, h, i, j ] + // ^ ^ + // first last + + // remove the unneeded elements at the end of the vector + Container::resize(this->size() - static_cast(elements_affected)); + + // [ a, b, c, d, h, i, j ] + // ^ ^ + // first last + + // first is now pointing past the last deleted element, but we cannot + // use this iterator, because it may have been invalidated by the + // resize call. Instead, we can return begin() + offset. + return Container::begin() + offset; + } + + size_type count(const Key& key) const + { + for (auto it = this->begin(); it != this->end(); ++it) + { + if (it->first == key) + { + return 1; + } + } + return 0; + } + + iterator find(const Key& key) + { + for (auto it = this->begin(); it != this->end(); ++it) + { + if (it->first == key) + { + return it; + } + } + return Container::end(); + } + + const_iterator find(const Key& key) const + { + for (auto it = this->begin(); it != this->end(); ++it) + { + if (it->first == key) + { + return it; + } + } + return Container::end(); + } + + std::pair insert( value_type&& value ) + { + return emplace(value.first, std::move(value.second)); + } + + std::pair insert( const value_type& value ) + { + for (auto it = this->begin(); it != this->end(); ++it) + { + if (it->first == value.first) + { + return {it, false}; + } + } + Container::push_back(value); + return {--this->end(), true}; + } + + template + using require_input_iter = typename std::enable_if::iterator_category, + std::input_iterator_tag>::value>::type; + + template> + void insert(InputIt first, InputIt last) + { + for (auto it = first; it != last; ++it) + { + insert(*it); + } + } +}; + +} // namespace nlohmann + + +#if defined(JSON_HAS_CPP_17) + #include +#endif + +/*! +@brief namespace for Niels Lohmann +@see https://github.com/nlohmann +@since version 1.0.0 +*/ +namespace nlohmann +{ + +/*! +@brief a class to store JSON values + +@internal +@invariant The member variables @a m_value and @a m_type have the following +relationship: +- If `m_type == value_t::object`, then `m_value.object != nullptr`. +- If `m_type == value_t::array`, then `m_value.array != nullptr`. +- If `m_type == value_t::string`, then `m_value.string != nullptr`. +The invariants are checked by member function assert_invariant(). + +@note ObjectType trick from https://stackoverflow.com/a/9860911 +@endinternal + +@since version 1.0.0 + +@nosubgrouping +*/ +NLOHMANN_BASIC_JSON_TPL_DECLARATION +class basic_json // NOLINT(cppcoreguidelines-special-member-functions,hicpp-special-member-functions) +{ + private: + template friend struct detail::external_constructor; + friend ::nlohmann::json_pointer; + + template + friend class ::nlohmann::detail::parser; + friend ::nlohmann::detail::serializer; + template + friend class ::nlohmann::detail::iter_impl; + template + friend class ::nlohmann::detail::binary_writer; + template + friend class ::nlohmann::detail::binary_reader; + template + friend class ::nlohmann::detail::json_sax_dom_parser; + template + friend class ::nlohmann::detail::json_sax_dom_callback_parser; + friend class ::nlohmann::detail::exception; + + /// workaround type for MSVC + using basic_json_t = NLOHMANN_BASIC_JSON_TPL; + + JSON_PRIVATE_UNLESS_TESTED: + // convenience aliases for types residing in namespace detail; + using lexer = ::nlohmann::detail::lexer_base; + + template + static ::nlohmann::detail::parser parser( + InputAdapterType adapter, + detail::parser_callback_tcb = nullptr, + const bool allow_exceptions = true, + const bool ignore_comments = false + ) + { + return ::nlohmann::detail::parser(std::move(adapter), + std::move(cb), allow_exceptions, ignore_comments); + } + + private: + using primitive_iterator_t = ::nlohmann::detail::primitive_iterator_t; + template + using internal_iterator = ::nlohmann::detail::internal_iterator; + template + using iter_impl = ::nlohmann::detail::iter_impl; + template + using iteration_proxy = ::nlohmann::detail::iteration_proxy; + template using json_reverse_iterator = ::nlohmann::detail::json_reverse_iterator; + + template + using output_adapter_t = ::nlohmann::detail::output_adapter_t; + + template + using binary_reader = ::nlohmann::detail::binary_reader; + template using binary_writer = ::nlohmann::detail::binary_writer; + + JSON_PRIVATE_UNLESS_TESTED: + using serializer = ::nlohmann::detail::serializer; + + public: + using value_t = detail::value_t; + /// JSON Pointer, see @ref nlohmann::json_pointer + using json_pointer = ::nlohmann::json_pointer; + template + using json_serializer = JSONSerializer; + /// how to treat decoding errors + using error_handler_t = detail::error_handler_t; + /// how to treat CBOR tags + using cbor_tag_handler_t = detail::cbor_tag_handler_t; + /// helper type for initializer lists of basic_json values + using initializer_list_t = std::initializer_list>; + + using input_format_t = detail::input_format_t; + /// SAX interface type, see @ref nlohmann::json_sax + using json_sax_t = json_sax; + + //////////////// + // exceptions // + //////////////// + + /// @name exceptions + /// Classes to implement user-defined exceptions. + /// @{ + + using exception = detail::exception; + using parse_error = detail::parse_error; + using invalid_iterator = detail::invalid_iterator; + using type_error = detail::type_error; + using out_of_range = detail::out_of_range; + using other_error = detail::other_error; + + /// @} + + + ///////////////////// + // container types // + ///////////////////// + + /// @name container types + /// The canonic container types to use @ref basic_json like any other STL + /// container. + /// @{ + + /// the type of elements in a basic_json container + using value_type = basic_json; + + /// the type of an element reference + using reference = value_type&; + /// the type of an element const reference + using const_reference = const value_type&; + + /// a type to represent differences between iterators + using difference_type = std::ptrdiff_t; + /// a type to represent container sizes + using size_type = std::size_t; + + /// the allocator type + using allocator_type = AllocatorType; + + /// the type of an element pointer + using pointer = typename std::allocator_traits::pointer; + /// the type of an element const pointer + using const_pointer = typename std::allocator_traits::const_pointer; + + /// an iterator for a basic_json container + using iterator = iter_impl; + /// a const iterator for a basic_json container + using const_iterator = iter_impl; + /// a reverse iterator for a basic_json container + using reverse_iterator = json_reverse_iterator; + /// a const reverse iterator for a basic_json container + using const_reverse_iterator = json_reverse_iterator; + + /// @} + + + /// @brief returns the allocator associated with the container + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/get_allocator/ + static allocator_type get_allocator() + { + return allocator_type(); + } + + /// @brief returns version information on the library + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/meta/ + JSON_HEDLEY_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT + static basic_json meta() + { + basic_json result; + + result["copyright"] = "(C) 2013-2022 Niels Lohmann"; + result["name"] = "JSON for Modern C++"; + result["url"] = "https://github.com/nlohmann/json"; + result["version"]["string"] = + std::to_string(NLOHMANN_JSON_VERSION_MAJOR) + "." + + std::to_string(NLOHMANN_JSON_VERSION_MINOR) + "." + + std::to_string(NLOHMANN_JSON_VERSION_PATCH); + result["version"]["major"] = NLOHMANN_JSON_VERSION_MAJOR; + result["version"]["minor"] = NLOHMANN_JSON_VERSION_MINOR; + result["version"]["patch"] = NLOHMANN_JSON_VERSION_PATCH; + +#ifdef _WIN32 + result["platform"] = "win32"; +#elif defined __linux__ + result["platform"] = "linux"; +#elif defined __APPLE__ + result["platform"] = "apple"; +#elif defined __unix__ + result["platform"] = "unix"; +#else + result["platform"] = "unknown"; +#endif + +#if defined(__ICC) || defined(__INTEL_COMPILER) + result["compiler"] = {{"family", "icc"}, {"version", __INTEL_COMPILER}}; +#elif defined(__clang__) + result["compiler"] = {{"family", "clang"}, {"version", __clang_version__}}; +#elif defined(__GNUC__) || defined(__GNUG__) + result["compiler"] = {{"family", "gcc"}, {"version", std::to_string(__GNUC__) + "." + std::to_string(__GNUC_MINOR__) + "." + std::to_string(__GNUC_PATCHLEVEL__)}}; +#elif defined(__HP_cc) || defined(__HP_aCC) + result["compiler"] = "hp" +#elif defined(__IBMCPP__) + result["compiler"] = {{"family", "ilecpp"}, {"version", __IBMCPP__}}; +#elif defined(_MSC_VER) + result["compiler"] = {{"family", "msvc"}, {"version", _MSC_VER}}; +#elif defined(__PGI) + result["compiler"] = {{"family", "pgcpp"}, {"version", __PGI}}; +#elif defined(__SUNPRO_CC) + result["compiler"] = {{"family", "sunpro"}, {"version", __SUNPRO_CC}}; +#else + result["compiler"] = {{"family", "unknown"}, {"version", "unknown"}}; +#endif + +#ifdef __cplusplus + result["compiler"]["c++"] = std::to_string(__cplusplus); +#else + result["compiler"]["c++"] = "unknown"; +#endif + return result; + } + + + /////////////////////////// + // JSON value data types // + /////////////////////////// + + /// @name JSON value data types + /// The data types to store a JSON value. These types are derived from + /// the template arguments passed to class @ref basic_json. + /// @{ + + /// @brief object key comparator type + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/object_comparator_t/ +#if defined(JSON_HAS_CPP_14) + // Use transparent comparator if possible, combined with perfect forwarding + // on find() and count() calls prevents unnecessary string construction. + using object_comparator_t = std::less<>; +#else + using object_comparator_t = std::less; +#endif + + /// @brief a type for an object + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/object_t/ + using object_t = ObjectType>>; + + /// @brief a type for an array + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/array_t/ + using array_t = ArrayType>; + + /// @brief a type for a string + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/string_t/ + using string_t = StringType; + + /// @brief a type for a boolean + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/boolean_t/ + using boolean_t = BooleanType; + + /// @brief a type for a number (integer) + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/number_integer_t/ + using number_integer_t = NumberIntegerType; + + /// @brief a type for a number (unsigned) + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/number_unsigned_t/ + using number_unsigned_t = NumberUnsignedType; + + /// @brief a type for a number (floating-point) + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/number_float_t/ + using number_float_t = NumberFloatType; + + /// @brief a type for a packed binary type + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/binary_t/ + using binary_t = nlohmann::byte_container_with_subtype; + + /// @} + + private: + + /// helper for exception-safe object creation + template + JSON_HEDLEY_RETURNS_NON_NULL + static T* create(Args&& ... args) + { + AllocatorType alloc; + using AllocatorTraits = std::allocator_traits>; + + auto deleter = [&](T * obj) + { + AllocatorTraits::deallocate(alloc, obj, 1); + }; + std::unique_ptr obj(AllocatorTraits::allocate(alloc, 1), deleter); + AllocatorTraits::construct(alloc, obj.get(), std::forward(args)...); + JSON_ASSERT(obj != nullptr); + return obj.release(); + } + + //////////////////////// + // JSON value storage // + //////////////////////// + + JSON_PRIVATE_UNLESS_TESTED: + /*! + @brief a JSON value + + The actual storage for a JSON value of the @ref basic_json class. This + union combines the different storage types for the JSON value types + defined in @ref value_t. + + JSON type | value_t type | used type + --------- | --------------- | ------------------------ + object | object | pointer to @ref object_t + array | array | pointer to @ref array_t + string | string | pointer to @ref string_t + boolean | boolean | @ref boolean_t + number | number_integer | @ref number_integer_t + number | number_unsigned | @ref number_unsigned_t + number | number_float | @ref number_float_t + binary | binary | pointer to @ref binary_t + null | null | *no value is stored* + + @note Variable-length types (objects, arrays, and strings) are stored as + pointers. The size of the union should not exceed 64 bits if the default + value types are used. + + @since version 1.0.0 + */ + union json_value + { + /// object (stored with pointer to save storage) + object_t* object; + /// array (stored with pointer to save storage) + array_t* array; + /// string (stored with pointer to save storage) + string_t* string; + /// binary (stored with pointer to save storage) + binary_t* binary; + /// boolean + boolean_t boolean; + /// number (integer) + number_integer_t number_integer; + /// number (unsigned integer) + number_unsigned_t number_unsigned; + /// number (floating-point) + number_float_t number_float; + + /// default constructor (for null values) + json_value() = default; + /// constructor for booleans + json_value(boolean_t v) noexcept : boolean(v) {} + /// constructor for numbers (integer) + json_value(number_integer_t v) noexcept : number_integer(v) {} + /// constructor for numbers (unsigned) + json_value(number_unsigned_t v) noexcept : number_unsigned(v) {} + /// constructor for numbers (floating-point) + json_value(number_float_t v) noexcept : number_float(v) {} + /// constructor for empty values of a given type + json_value(value_t t) + { + switch (t) + { + case value_t::object: + { + object = create(); + break; + } + + case value_t::array: + { + array = create(); + break; + } + + case value_t::string: + { + string = create(""); + break; + } + + case value_t::binary: + { + binary = create(); + break; + } + + case value_t::boolean: + { + boolean = static_cast(false); + break; + } + + case value_t::number_integer: + { + number_integer = static_cast(0); + break; + } + + case value_t::number_unsigned: + { + number_unsigned = static_cast(0); + break; + } + + case value_t::number_float: + { + number_float = static_cast(0.0); + break; + } + + case value_t::null: + { + object = nullptr; // silence warning, see #821 + break; + } + + case value_t::discarded: + default: + { + object = nullptr; // silence warning, see #821 + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(t == value_t::null)) + { + JSON_THROW(other_error::create(500, "961c151d2e87f2686a955a9be24d316f1362bf21 3.10.5", basic_json())); // LCOV_EXCL_LINE + } + break; + } + } + } + + /// constructor for strings + json_value(const string_t& value) : string(create(value)) {} + + /// constructor for rvalue strings + json_value(string_t&& value) : string(create(std::move(value))) {} + + /// constructor for objects + json_value(const object_t& value) : object(create(value)) {} + + /// constructor for rvalue objects + json_value(object_t&& value) : object(create(std::move(value))) {} + + /// constructor for arrays + json_value(const array_t& value) : array(create(value)) {} + + /// constructor for rvalue arrays + json_value(array_t&& value) : array(create(std::move(value))) {} + + /// constructor for binary arrays + json_value(const typename binary_t::container_type& value) : binary(create(value)) {} + + /// constructor for rvalue binary arrays + json_value(typename binary_t::container_type&& value) : binary(create(std::move(value))) {} + + /// constructor for binary arrays (internal type) + json_value(const binary_t& value) : binary(create(value)) {} + + /// constructor for rvalue binary arrays (internal type) + json_value(binary_t&& value) : binary(create(std::move(value))) {} + + void destroy(value_t t) + { + if (t == value_t::array || t == value_t::object) + { + // flatten the current json_value to a heap-allocated stack + std::vector stack; + + // move the top-level items to stack + if (t == value_t::array) + { + stack.reserve(array->size()); + std::move(array->begin(), array->end(), std::back_inserter(stack)); + } + else + { + stack.reserve(object->size()); + for (auto&& it : *object) + { + stack.push_back(std::move(it.second)); + } + } + + while (!stack.empty()) + { + // move the last item to local variable to be processed + basic_json current_item(std::move(stack.back())); + stack.pop_back(); + + // if current_item is array/object, move + // its children to the stack to be processed later + if (current_item.is_array()) + { + std::move(current_item.m_value.array->begin(), current_item.m_value.array->end(), std::back_inserter(stack)); + + current_item.m_value.array->clear(); + } + else if (current_item.is_object()) + { + for (auto&& it : *current_item.m_value.object) + { + stack.push_back(std::move(it.second)); + } + + current_item.m_value.object->clear(); + } + + // it's now safe that current_item get destructed + // since it doesn't have any children + } + } + + switch (t) + { + case value_t::object: + { + AllocatorType alloc; + std::allocator_traits::destroy(alloc, object); + std::allocator_traits::deallocate(alloc, object, 1); + break; + } + + case value_t::array: + { + AllocatorType alloc; + std::allocator_traits::destroy(alloc, array); + std::allocator_traits::deallocate(alloc, array, 1); + break; + } + + case value_t::string: + { + AllocatorType alloc; + std::allocator_traits::destroy(alloc, string); + std::allocator_traits::deallocate(alloc, string, 1); + break; + } + + case value_t::binary: + { + AllocatorType alloc; + std::allocator_traits::destroy(alloc, binary); + std::allocator_traits::deallocate(alloc, binary, 1); + break; + } + + case value_t::null: + case value_t::boolean: + case value_t::number_integer: + case value_t::number_unsigned: + case value_t::number_float: + case value_t::discarded: + default: + { + break; + } + } + } + }; + + private: + /*! + @brief checks the class invariants + + This function asserts the class invariants. It needs to be called at the + end of every constructor to make sure that created objects respect the + invariant. Furthermore, it has to be called each time the type of a JSON + value is changed, because the invariant expresses a relationship between + @a m_type and @a m_value. + + Furthermore, the parent relation is checked for arrays and objects: If + @a check_parents true and the value is an array or object, then the + container's elements must have the current value as parent. + + @param[in] check_parents whether the parent relation should be checked. + The value is true by default and should only be set to false + during destruction of objects when the invariant does not + need to hold. + */ + void assert_invariant(bool check_parents = true) const noexcept + { + JSON_ASSERT(m_type != value_t::object || m_value.object != nullptr); + JSON_ASSERT(m_type != value_t::array || m_value.array != nullptr); + JSON_ASSERT(m_type != value_t::string || m_value.string != nullptr); + JSON_ASSERT(m_type != value_t::binary || m_value.binary != nullptr); + +#if JSON_DIAGNOSTICS + JSON_TRY + { + // cppcheck-suppress assertWithSideEffect + JSON_ASSERT(!check_parents || !is_structured() || std::all_of(begin(), end(), [this](const basic_json & j) + { + return j.m_parent == this; + })); + } + JSON_CATCH(...) {} // LCOV_EXCL_LINE +#endif + static_cast(check_parents); + } + + void set_parents() + { +#if JSON_DIAGNOSTICS + switch (m_type) + { + case value_t::array: + { + for (auto& element : *m_value.array) + { + element.m_parent = this; + } + break; + } + + case value_t::object: + { + for (auto& element : *m_value.object) + { + element.second.m_parent = this; + } + break; + } + + case value_t::null: + case value_t::string: + case value_t::boolean: + case value_t::number_integer: + case value_t::number_unsigned: + case value_t::number_float: + case value_t::binary: + case value_t::discarded: + default: + break; + } +#endif + } + + iterator set_parents(iterator it, typename iterator::difference_type count_set_parents) + { +#if JSON_DIAGNOSTICS + for (typename iterator::difference_type i = 0; i < count_set_parents; ++i) + { + (it + i)->m_parent = this; + } +#else + static_cast(count_set_parents); +#endif + return it; + } + + reference set_parent(reference j, std::size_t old_capacity = static_cast(-1)) + { +#if JSON_DIAGNOSTICS + if (old_capacity != static_cast(-1)) + { + // see https://github.com/nlohmann/json/issues/2838 + JSON_ASSERT(type() == value_t::array); + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(m_value.array->capacity() != old_capacity)) + { + // capacity has changed: update all parents + set_parents(); + return j; + } + } + + // ordered_json uses a vector internally, so pointers could have + // been invalidated; see https://github.com/nlohmann/json/issues/2962 +#ifdef JSON_HEDLEY_MSVC_VERSION +#pragma warning(push ) +#pragma warning(disable : 4127) // ignore warning to replace if with if constexpr +#endif + if (detail::is_ordered_map::value) + { + set_parents(); + return j; + } +#ifdef JSON_HEDLEY_MSVC_VERSION +#pragma warning( pop ) +#endif + + j.m_parent = this; +#else + static_cast(j); + static_cast(old_capacity); +#endif + return j; + } + + public: + ////////////////////////// + // JSON parser callback // + ////////////////////////// + + /// @brief parser event types + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/parse_event_t/ + using parse_event_t = detail::parse_event_t; + + /// @brief per-element parser callback type + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/parser_callback_t/ + using parser_callback_t = detail::parser_callback_t; + + ////////////////// + // constructors // + ////////////////// + + /// @name constructors and destructors + /// Constructors of class @ref basic_json, copy/move constructor, copy + /// assignment, static functions creating objects, and the destructor. + /// @{ + + /// @brief create an empty value with a given type + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/basic_json/ + basic_json(const value_t v) + : m_type(v), m_value(v) + { + assert_invariant(); + } + + /// @brief create a null object + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/basic_json/ + basic_json(std::nullptr_t = nullptr) noexcept + : basic_json(value_t::null) + { + assert_invariant(); + } + + /// @brief create a JSON value from compatible types + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/basic_json/ + template < typename CompatibleType, + typename U = detail::uncvref_t, + detail::enable_if_t < + !detail::is_basic_json::value && detail::is_compatible_type::value, int > = 0 > + basic_json(CompatibleType && val) noexcept(noexcept( // NOLINT(bugprone-forwarding-reference-overload,bugprone-exception-escape) + JSONSerializer::to_json(std::declval(), + std::forward(val)))) + { + JSONSerializer::to_json(*this, std::forward(val)); + set_parents(); + assert_invariant(); + } + + /// @brief create a JSON value from an existing one + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/basic_json/ + template < typename BasicJsonType, + detail::enable_if_t < + detail::is_basic_json::value&& !std::is_same::value, int > = 0 > + basic_json(const BasicJsonType& val) + { + using other_boolean_t = typename BasicJsonType::boolean_t; + using other_number_float_t = typename BasicJsonType::number_float_t; + using other_number_integer_t = typename BasicJsonType::number_integer_t; + using other_number_unsigned_t = typename BasicJsonType::number_unsigned_t; + using other_string_t = typename BasicJsonType::string_t; + using other_object_t = typename BasicJsonType::object_t; + using other_array_t = typename BasicJsonType::array_t; + using other_binary_t = typename BasicJsonType::binary_t; + + switch (val.type()) + { + case value_t::boolean: + JSONSerializer::to_json(*this, val.template get()); + break; + case value_t::number_float: + JSONSerializer::to_json(*this, val.template get()); + break; + case value_t::number_integer: + JSONSerializer::to_json(*this, val.template get()); + break; + case value_t::number_unsigned: + JSONSerializer::to_json(*this, val.template get()); + break; + case value_t::string: + JSONSerializer::to_json(*this, val.template get_ref()); + break; + case value_t::object: + JSONSerializer::to_json(*this, val.template get_ref()); + break; + case value_t::array: + JSONSerializer::to_json(*this, val.template get_ref()); + break; + case value_t::binary: + JSONSerializer::to_json(*this, val.template get_ref()); + break; + case value_t::null: + *this = nullptr; + break; + case value_t::discarded: + m_type = value_t::discarded; + break; + default: // LCOV_EXCL_LINE + JSON_ASSERT(false); // NOLINT(cert-dcl03-c,hicpp-static-assert,misc-static-assert) LCOV_EXCL_LINE + } + set_parents(); + assert_invariant(); + } + + /// @brief create a container (array or object) from an initializer list + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/basic_json/ + basic_json(initializer_list_t init, + bool type_deduction = true, + value_t manual_type = value_t::array) + { + // check if each element is an array with two elements whose first + // element is a string + bool is_an_object = std::all_of(init.begin(), init.end(), + [](const detail::json_ref& element_ref) + { + return element_ref->is_array() && element_ref->size() == 2 && (*element_ref)[0].is_string(); + }); + + // adjust type if type deduction is not wanted + if (!type_deduction) + { + // if array is wanted, do not create an object though possible + if (manual_type == value_t::array) + { + is_an_object = false; + } + + // if object is wanted but impossible, throw an exception + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(manual_type == value_t::object && !is_an_object)) + { + JSON_THROW(type_error::create(301, "cannot create object from initializer list", basic_json())); + } + } + + if (is_an_object) + { + // the initializer list is a list of pairs -> create object + m_type = value_t::object; + m_value = value_t::object; + + for (auto& element_ref : init) + { + auto element = element_ref.moved_or_copied(); + m_value.object->emplace( + std::move(*((*element.m_value.array)[0].m_value.string)), + std::move((*element.m_value.array)[1])); + } + } + else + { + // the initializer list describes an array -> create array + m_type = value_t::array; + m_value.array = create(init.begin(), init.end()); + } + + set_parents(); + assert_invariant(); + } + + /// @brief explicitly create a binary array (without subtype) + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/binary/ + JSON_HEDLEY_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT + static basic_json binary(const typename binary_t::container_type& init) + { + auto res = basic_json(); + res.m_type = value_t::binary; + res.m_value = init; + return res; + } + + /// @brief explicitly create a binary array (with subtype) + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/binary/ + JSON_HEDLEY_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT + static basic_json binary(const typename binary_t::container_type& init, typename binary_t::subtype_type subtype) + { + auto res = basic_json(); + res.m_type = value_t::binary; + res.m_value = binary_t(init, subtype); + return res; + } + + /// @brief explicitly create a binary array + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/binary/ + JSON_HEDLEY_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT + static basic_json binary(typename binary_t::container_type&& init) + { + auto res = basic_json(); + res.m_type = value_t::binary; + res.m_value = std::move(init); + return res; + } + + /// @brief explicitly create a binary array (with subtype) + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/binary/ + JSON_HEDLEY_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT + static basic_json binary(typename binary_t::container_type&& init, typename binary_t::subtype_type subtype) + { + auto res = basic_json(); + res.m_type = value_t::binary; + res.m_value = binary_t(std::move(init), subtype); + return res; + } + + /// @brief explicitly create an array from an initializer list + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/array/ + JSON_HEDLEY_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT + static basic_json array(initializer_list_t init = {}) + { + return basic_json(init, false, value_t::array); + } + + /// @brief explicitly create an object from an initializer list + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/object/ + JSON_HEDLEY_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT + static basic_json object(initializer_list_t init = {}) + { + return basic_json(init, false, value_t::object); + } + + /// @brief construct an array with count copies of given value + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/basic_json/ + basic_json(size_type cnt, const basic_json& val) + : m_type(value_t::array) + { + m_value.array = create(cnt, val); + set_parents(); + assert_invariant(); + } + + /// @brief construct a JSON container given an iterator range + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/basic_json/ + template < class InputIT, typename std::enable_if < + std::is_same::value || + std::is_same::value, int >::type = 0 > + basic_json(InputIT first, InputIT last) + { + JSON_ASSERT(first.m_object != nullptr); + JSON_ASSERT(last.m_object != nullptr); + + // make sure iterator fits the current value + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(first.m_object != last.m_object)) + { + JSON_THROW(invalid_iterator::create(201, "iterators are not compatible", basic_json())); + } + + // copy type from first iterator + m_type = first.m_object->m_type; + + // check if iterator range is complete for primitive values + switch (m_type) + { + case value_t::boolean: + case value_t::number_float: + case value_t::number_integer: + case value_t::number_unsigned: + case value_t::string: + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!first.m_it.primitive_iterator.is_begin() + || !last.m_it.primitive_iterator.is_end())) + { + JSON_THROW(invalid_iterator::create(204, "iterators out of range", *first.m_object)); + } + break; + } + + case value_t::null: + case value_t::object: + case value_t::array: + case value_t::binary: + case value_t::discarded: + default: + break; + } + + switch (m_type) + { + case value_t::number_integer: + { + m_value.number_integer = first.m_object->m_value.number_integer; + break; + } + + case value_t::number_unsigned: + { + m_value.number_unsigned = first.m_object->m_value.number_unsigned; + break; + } + + case value_t::number_float: + { + m_value.number_float = first.m_object->m_value.number_float; + break; + } + + case value_t::boolean: + { + m_value.boolean = first.m_object->m_value.boolean; + break; + } + + case value_t::string: + { + m_value = *first.m_object->m_value.string; + break; + } + + case value_t::object: + { + m_value.object = create(first.m_it.object_iterator, + last.m_it.object_iterator); + break; + } + + case value_t::array: + { + m_value.array = create(first.m_it.array_iterator, + last.m_it.array_iterator); + break; + } + + case value_t::binary: + { + m_value = *first.m_object->m_value.binary; + break; + } + + case value_t::null: + case value_t::discarded: + default: + JSON_THROW(invalid_iterator::create(206, "cannot construct with iterators from " + std::string(first.m_object->type_name()), *first.m_object)); + } + + set_parents(); + assert_invariant(); + } + + + /////////////////////////////////////// + // other constructors and destructor // + /////////////////////////////////////// + + template, + std::is_same>::value, int> = 0 > + basic_json(const JsonRef& ref) : basic_json(ref.moved_or_copied()) {} + + /// @brief copy constructor + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/basic_json/ + basic_json(const basic_json& other) + : m_type(other.m_type) + { + // check of passed value is valid + other.assert_invariant(); + + switch (m_type) + { + case value_t::object: + { + m_value = *other.m_value.object; + break; + } + + case value_t::array: + { + m_value = *other.m_value.array; + break; + } + + case value_t::string: + { + m_value = *other.m_value.string; + break; + } + + case value_t::boolean: + { + m_value = other.m_value.boolean; + break; + } + + case value_t::number_integer: + { + m_value = other.m_value.number_integer; + break; + } + + case value_t::number_unsigned: + { + m_value = other.m_value.number_unsigned; + break; + } + + case value_t::number_float: + { + m_value = other.m_value.number_float; + break; + } + + case value_t::binary: + { + m_value = *other.m_value.binary; + break; + } + + case value_t::null: + case value_t::discarded: + default: + break; + } + + set_parents(); + assert_invariant(); + } + + /// @brief move constructor + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/basic_json/ + basic_json(basic_json&& other) noexcept + : m_type(std::move(other.m_type)), + m_value(std::move(other.m_value)) + { + // check that passed value is valid + other.assert_invariant(false); + + // invalidate payload + other.m_type = value_t::null; + other.m_value = {}; + + set_parents(); + assert_invariant(); + } + + /// @brief copy assignment + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/operator=/ + basic_json& operator=(basic_json other) noexcept ( + std::is_nothrow_move_constructible::value&& + std::is_nothrow_move_assignable::value&& + std::is_nothrow_move_constructible::value&& + std::is_nothrow_move_assignable::value + ) + { + // check that passed value is valid + other.assert_invariant(); + + using std::swap; + swap(m_type, other.m_type); + swap(m_value, other.m_value); + + set_parents(); + assert_invariant(); + return *this; + } + + /// @brief destructor + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/~basic_json/ + ~basic_json() noexcept + { + assert_invariant(false); + m_value.destroy(m_type); + } + + /// @} + + public: + /////////////////////// + // object inspection // + /////////////////////// + + /// @name object inspection + /// Functions to inspect the type of a JSON value. + /// @{ + + /// @brief serialization + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/dump/ + string_t dump(const int indent = -1, + const char indent_char = ' ', + const bool ensure_ascii = false, + const error_handler_t error_handler = error_handler_t::strict) const + { + string_t result; + serializer s(detail::output_adapter(result), indent_char, error_handler); + + if (indent >= 0) + { + s.dump(*this, true, ensure_ascii, static_cast(indent)); + } + else + { + s.dump(*this, false, ensure_ascii, 0); + } + + return result; + } + + /// @brief return the type of the JSON value (explicit) + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/type/ + constexpr value_t type() const noexcept + { + return m_type; + } + + /// @brief return whether type is primitive + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/is_primitive/ + constexpr bool is_primitive() const noexcept + { + return is_null() || is_string() || is_boolean() || is_number() || is_binary(); + } + + /// @brief return whether type is structured + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/is_structured/ + constexpr bool is_structured() const noexcept + { + return is_array() || is_object(); + } + + /// @brief return whether value is null + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/is_null/ + constexpr bool is_null() const noexcept + { + return m_type == value_t::null; + } + + /// @brief return whether value is a boolean + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/is_boolean/ + constexpr bool is_boolean() const noexcept + { + return m_type == value_t::boolean; + } + + /// @brief return whether value is a number + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/is_number/ + constexpr bool is_number() const noexcept + { + return is_number_integer() || is_number_float(); + } + + /// @brief return whether value is an integer number + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/is_number_integer/ + constexpr bool is_number_integer() const noexcept + { + return m_type == value_t::number_integer || m_type == value_t::number_unsigned; + } + + /// @brief return whether value is an unsigned integer number + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/is_number_unsigned/ + constexpr bool is_number_unsigned() const noexcept + { + return m_type == value_t::number_unsigned; + } + + /// @brief return whether value is a floating-point number + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/is_number_float/ + constexpr bool is_number_float() const noexcept + { + return m_type == value_t::number_float; + } + + /// @brief return whether value is an object + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/is_object/ + constexpr bool is_object() const noexcept + { + return m_type == value_t::object; + } + + /// @brief return whether value is an array + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/is_array/ + constexpr bool is_array() const noexcept + { + return m_type == value_t::array; + } + + /// @brief return whether value is a string + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/is_string/ + constexpr bool is_string() const noexcept + { + return m_type == value_t::string; + } + + /// @brief return whether value is a binary array + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/is_binary/ + constexpr bool is_binary() const noexcept + { + return m_type == value_t::binary; + } + + /// @brief return whether value is discarded + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/is_discarded/ + constexpr bool is_discarded() const noexcept + { + return m_type == value_t::discarded; + } + + /// @brief return the type of the JSON value (implicit) + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/operator_value_t/ + constexpr operator value_t() const noexcept + { + return m_type; + } + + /// @} + + private: + ////////////////// + // value access // + ////////////////// + + /// get a boolean (explicit) + boolean_t get_impl(boolean_t* /*unused*/) const + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_LIKELY(is_boolean())) + { + return m_value.boolean; + } + + JSON_THROW(type_error::create(302, "type must be boolean, but is " + std::string(type_name()), *this)); + } + + /// get a pointer to the value (object) + object_t* get_impl_ptr(object_t* /*unused*/) noexcept + { + return is_object() ? m_value.object : nullptr; + } + + /// get a pointer to the value (object) + constexpr const object_t* get_impl_ptr(const object_t* /*unused*/) const noexcept + { + return is_object() ? m_value.object : nullptr; + } + + /// get a pointer to the value (array) + array_t* get_impl_ptr(array_t* /*unused*/) noexcept + { + return is_array() ? m_value.array : nullptr; + } + + /// get a pointer to the value (array) + constexpr const array_t* get_impl_ptr(const array_t* /*unused*/) const noexcept + { + return is_array() ? m_value.array : nullptr; + } + + /// get a pointer to the value (string) + string_t* get_impl_ptr(string_t* /*unused*/) noexcept + { + return is_string() ? m_value.string : nullptr; + } + + /// get a pointer to the value (string) + constexpr const string_t* get_impl_ptr(const string_t* /*unused*/) const noexcept + { + return is_string() ? m_value.string : nullptr; + } + + /// get a pointer to the value (boolean) + boolean_t* get_impl_ptr(boolean_t* /*unused*/) noexcept + { + return is_boolean() ? &m_value.boolean : nullptr; + } + + /// get a pointer to the value (boolean) + constexpr const boolean_t* get_impl_ptr(const boolean_t* /*unused*/) const noexcept + { + return is_boolean() ? &m_value.boolean : nullptr; + } + + /// get a pointer to the value (integer number) + number_integer_t* get_impl_ptr(number_integer_t* /*unused*/) noexcept + { + return is_number_integer() ? &m_value.number_integer : nullptr; + } + + /// get a pointer to the value (integer number) + constexpr const number_integer_t* get_impl_ptr(const number_integer_t* /*unused*/) const noexcept + { + return is_number_integer() ? &m_value.number_integer : nullptr; + } + + /// get a pointer to the value (unsigned number) + number_unsigned_t* get_impl_ptr(number_unsigned_t* /*unused*/) noexcept + { + return is_number_unsigned() ? &m_value.number_unsigned : nullptr; + } + + /// get a pointer to the value (unsigned number) + constexpr const number_unsigned_t* get_impl_ptr(const number_unsigned_t* /*unused*/) const noexcept + { + return is_number_unsigned() ? &m_value.number_unsigned : nullptr; + } + + /// get a pointer to the value (floating-point number) + number_float_t* get_impl_ptr(number_float_t* /*unused*/) noexcept + { + return is_number_float() ? &m_value.number_float : nullptr; + } + + /// get a pointer to the value (floating-point number) + constexpr const number_float_t* get_impl_ptr(const number_float_t* /*unused*/) const noexcept + { + return is_number_float() ? &m_value.number_float : nullptr; + } + + /// get a pointer to the value (binary) + binary_t* get_impl_ptr(binary_t* /*unused*/) noexcept + { + return is_binary() ? m_value.binary : nullptr; + } + + /// get a pointer to the value (binary) + constexpr const binary_t* get_impl_ptr(const binary_t* /*unused*/) const noexcept + { + return is_binary() ? m_value.binary : nullptr; + } + + /*! + @brief helper function to implement get_ref() + + This function helps to implement get_ref() without code duplication for + const and non-const overloads + + @tparam ThisType will be deduced as `basic_json` or `const basic_json` + + @throw type_error.303 if ReferenceType does not match underlying value + type of the current JSON + */ + template + static ReferenceType get_ref_impl(ThisType& obj) + { + // delegate the call to get_ptr<>() + auto* ptr = obj.template get_ptr::type>(); + + if (JSON_HEDLEY_LIKELY(ptr != nullptr)) + { + return *ptr; + } + + JSON_THROW(type_error::create(303, "incompatible ReferenceType for get_ref, actual type is " + std::string(obj.type_name()), obj)); + } + + public: + /// @name value access + /// Direct access to the stored value of a JSON value. + /// @{ + + /// @brief get a pointer value (implicit) + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/get_ptr/ + template::value, int>::type = 0> + auto get_ptr() noexcept -> decltype(std::declval().get_impl_ptr(std::declval())) + { + // delegate the call to get_impl_ptr<>() + return get_impl_ptr(static_cast(nullptr)); + } + + /// @brief get a pointer value (implicit) + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/get_ptr/ + template < typename PointerType, typename std::enable_if < + std::is_pointer::value&& + std::is_const::type>::value, int >::type = 0 > + constexpr auto get_ptr() const noexcept -> decltype(std::declval().get_impl_ptr(std::declval())) + { + // delegate the call to get_impl_ptr<>() const + return get_impl_ptr(static_cast(nullptr)); + } + + private: + /*! + @brief get a value (explicit) + + Explicit type conversion between the JSON value and a compatible value + which is [CopyConstructible](https://en.cppreference.com/w/cpp/named_req/CopyConstructible) + and [DefaultConstructible](https://en.cppreference.com/w/cpp/named_req/DefaultConstructible). + The value is converted by calling the @ref json_serializer + `from_json()` method. + + The function is equivalent to executing + @code {.cpp} + ValueType ret; + JSONSerializer::from_json(*this, ret); + return ret; + @endcode + + This overloads is chosen if: + - @a ValueType is not @ref basic_json, + - @ref json_serializer has a `from_json()` method of the form + `void from_json(const basic_json&, ValueType&)`, and + - @ref json_serializer does not have a `from_json()` method of + the form `ValueType from_json(const basic_json&)` + + @tparam ValueType the returned value type + + @return copy of the JSON value, converted to @a ValueType + + @throw what @ref json_serializer `from_json()` method throws + + @liveexample{The example below shows several conversions from JSON values + to other types. There a few things to note: (1) Floating-point numbers can + be converted to integers\, (2) A JSON array can be converted to a standard + `std::vector`\, (3) A JSON object can be converted to C++ + associative containers such as `std::unordered_map`.,get__ValueType_const} + + @since version 2.1.0 + */ + template < typename ValueType, + detail::enable_if_t < + detail::is_default_constructible::value&& + detail::has_from_json::value, + int > = 0 > + ValueType get_impl(detail::priority_tag<0> /*unused*/) const noexcept(noexcept( + JSONSerializer::from_json(std::declval(), std::declval()))) + { + auto ret = ValueType(); + JSONSerializer::from_json(*this, ret); + return ret; + } + + /*! + @brief get a value (explicit); special case + + Explicit type conversion between the JSON value and a compatible value + which is **not** [CopyConstructible](https://en.cppreference.com/w/cpp/named_req/CopyConstructible) + and **not** [DefaultConstructible](https://en.cppreference.com/w/cpp/named_req/DefaultConstructible). + The value is converted by calling the @ref json_serializer + `from_json()` method. + + The function is equivalent to executing + @code {.cpp} + return JSONSerializer::from_json(*this); + @endcode + + This overloads is chosen if: + - @a ValueType is not @ref basic_json and + - @ref json_serializer has a `from_json()` method of the form + `ValueType from_json(const basic_json&)` + + @note If @ref json_serializer has both overloads of + `from_json()`, this one is chosen. + + @tparam ValueType the returned value type + + @return copy of the JSON value, converted to @a ValueType + + @throw what @ref json_serializer `from_json()` method throws + + @since version 2.1.0 + */ + template < typename ValueType, + detail::enable_if_t < + detail::has_non_default_from_json::value, + int > = 0 > + ValueType get_impl(detail::priority_tag<1> /*unused*/) const noexcept(noexcept( + JSONSerializer::from_json(std::declval()))) + { + return JSONSerializer::from_json(*this); + } + + /*! + @brief get special-case overload + + This overloads converts the current @ref basic_json in a different + @ref basic_json type + + @tparam BasicJsonType == @ref basic_json + + @return a copy of *this, converted into @a BasicJsonType + + @complexity Depending on the implementation of the called `from_json()` + method. + + @since version 3.2.0 + */ + template < typename BasicJsonType, + detail::enable_if_t < + detail::is_basic_json::value, + int > = 0 > + BasicJsonType get_impl(detail::priority_tag<2> /*unused*/) const + { + return *this; + } + + /*! + @brief get special-case overload + + This overloads avoids a lot of template boilerplate, it can be seen as the + identity method + + @tparam BasicJsonType == @ref basic_json + + @return a copy of *this + + @complexity Constant. + + @since version 2.1.0 + */ + template::value, + int> = 0> + basic_json get_impl(detail::priority_tag<3> /*unused*/) const + { + return *this; + } + + /*! + @brief get a pointer value (explicit) + @copydoc get() + */ + template::value, + int> = 0> + constexpr auto get_impl(detail::priority_tag<4> /*unused*/) const noexcept + -> decltype(std::declval().template get_ptr()) + { + // delegate the call to get_ptr + return get_ptr(); + } + + public: + /*! + @brief get a (pointer) value (explicit) + + Performs explicit type conversion between the JSON value and a compatible value if required. + + - If the requested type is a pointer to the internally stored JSON value that pointer is returned. + No copies are made. + + - If the requested type is the current @ref basic_json, or a different @ref basic_json convertible + from the current @ref basic_json. + + - Otherwise the value is converted by calling the @ref json_serializer `from_json()` + method. + + @tparam ValueTypeCV the provided value type + @tparam ValueType the returned value type + + @return copy of the JSON value, converted to @tparam ValueType if necessary + + @throw what @ref json_serializer `from_json()` method throws if conversion is required + + @since version 2.1.0 + */ + template < typename ValueTypeCV, typename ValueType = detail::uncvref_t> +#if defined(JSON_HAS_CPP_14) + constexpr +#endif + auto get() const noexcept( + noexcept(std::declval().template get_impl(detail::priority_tag<4> {}))) + -> decltype(std::declval().template get_impl(detail::priority_tag<4> {})) + { + // we cannot static_assert on ValueTypeCV being non-const, because + // there is support for get(), which is why we + // still need the uncvref + static_assert(!std::is_reference::value, + "get() cannot be used with reference types, you might want to use get_ref()"); + return get_impl(detail::priority_tag<4> {}); + } + + /*! + @brief get a pointer value (explicit) + + Explicit pointer access to the internally stored JSON value. No copies are + made. + + @warning The pointer becomes invalid if the underlying JSON object + changes. + + @tparam PointerType pointer type; must be a pointer to @ref array_t, @ref + object_t, @ref string_t, @ref boolean_t, @ref number_integer_t, + @ref number_unsigned_t, or @ref number_float_t. + + @return pointer to the internally stored JSON value if the requested + pointer type @a PointerType fits to the JSON value; `nullptr` otherwise + + @complexity Constant. + + @liveexample{The example below shows how pointers to internal values of a + JSON value can be requested. Note that no type conversions are made and a + `nullptr` is returned if the value and the requested pointer type does not + match.,get__PointerType} + + @sa see @ref get_ptr() for explicit pointer-member access + + @since version 1.0.0 + */ + template::value, int>::type = 0> + auto get() noexcept -> decltype(std::declval().template get_ptr()) + { + // delegate the call to get_ptr + return get_ptr(); + } + + /// @brief get a value (explicit) + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/get_to/ + template < typename ValueType, + detail::enable_if_t < + !detail::is_basic_json::value&& + detail::has_from_json::value, + int > = 0 > + ValueType & get_to(ValueType& v) const noexcept(noexcept( + JSONSerializer::from_json(std::declval(), v))) + { + JSONSerializer::from_json(*this, v); + return v; + } + + // specialization to allow calling get_to with a basic_json value + // see https://github.com/nlohmann/json/issues/2175 + template::value, + int> = 0> + ValueType & get_to(ValueType& v) const + { + v = *this; + return v; + } + + template < + typename T, std::size_t N, + typename Array = T (&)[N], // NOLINT(cppcoreguidelines-avoid-c-arrays,hicpp-avoid-c-arrays,modernize-avoid-c-arrays) + detail::enable_if_t < + detail::has_from_json::value, int > = 0 > + Array get_to(T (&v)[N]) const // NOLINT(cppcoreguidelines-avoid-c-arrays,hicpp-avoid-c-arrays,modernize-avoid-c-arrays) + noexcept(noexcept(JSONSerializer::from_json( + std::declval(), v))) + { + JSONSerializer::from_json(*this, v); + return v; + } + + /// @brief get a reference value (implicit) + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/get_ref/ + template::value, int>::type = 0> + ReferenceType get_ref() + { + // delegate call to get_ref_impl + return get_ref_impl(*this); + } + + /// @brief get a reference value (implicit) + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/get_ref/ + template < typename ReferenceType, typename std::enable_if < + std::is_reference::value&& + std::is_const::type>::value, int >::type = 0 > + ReferenceType get_ref() const + { + // delegate call to get_ref_impl + return get_ref_impl(*this); + } + + /*! + @brief get a value (implicit) + + Implicit type conversion between the JSON value and a compatible value. + The call is realized by calling @ref get() const. + + @tparam ValueType non-pointer type compatible to the JSON value, for + instance `int` for JSON integer numbers, `bool` for JSON booleans, or + `std::vector` types for JSON arrays. The character type of @ref string_t + as well as an initializer list of this type is excluded to avoid + ambiguities as these types implicitly convert to `std::string`. + + @return copy of the JSON value, converted to type @a ValueType + + @throw type_error.302 in case passed type @a ValueType is incompatible + to the JSON value type (e.g., the JSON value is of type boolean, but a + string is requested); see example below + + @complexity Linear in the size of the JSON value. + + @liveexample{The example below shows several conversions from JSON values + to other types. There a few things to note: (1) Floating-point numbers can + be converted to integers\, (2) A JSON array can be converted to a standard + `std::vector`\, (3) A JSON object can be converted to C++ + associative containers such as `std::unordered_map`.,operator__ValueType} + + @since version 1.0.0 + */ + template < typename ValueType, typename std::enable_if < + detail::conjunction < + detail::negation>, + detail::negation>>, + detail::negation>, + detail::negation>, + detail::negation>>, + +#if defined(JSON_HAS_CPP_17) && (defined(__GNUC__) || (defined(_MSC_VER) && _MSC_VER >= 1910 && _MSC_VER <= 1914)) + detail::negation>, +#endif + detail::is_detected_lazy + >::value, int >::type = 0 > + JSON_EXPLICIT operator ValueType() const + { + // delegate the call to get<>() const + return get(); + } + + /// @brief get a binary value + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/get_binary/ + binary_t& get_binary() + { + if (!is_binary()) + { + JSON_THROW(type_error::create(302, "type must be binary, but is " + std::string(type_name()), *this)); + } + + return *get_ptr(); + } + + /// @brief get a binary value + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/get_binary/ + const binary_t& get_binary() const + { + if (!is_binary()) + { + JSON_THROW(type_error::create(302, "type must be binary, but is " + std::string(type_name()), *this)); + } + + return *get_ptr(); + } + + /// @} + + + //////////////////// + // element access // + //////////////////// + + /// @name element access + /// Access to the JSON value. + /// @{ + + /// @brief access specified array element with bounds checking + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/at/ + reference at(size_type idx) + { + // at only works for arrays + if (JSON_HEDLEY_LIKELY(is_array())) + { + JSON_TRY + { + return set_parent(m_value.array->at(idx)); + } + JSON_CATCH (std::out_of_range&) + { + // create better exception explanation + JSON_THROW(out_of_range::create(401, "array index " + std::to_string(idx) + " is out of range", *this)); + } + } + else + { + JSON_THROW(type_error::create(304, "cannot use at() with " + std::string(type_name()), *this)); + } + } + + /// @brief access specified array element with bounds checking + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/at/ + const_reference at(size_type idx) const + { + // at only works for arrays + if (JSON_HEDLEY_LIKELY(is_array())) + { + JSON_TRY + { + return m_value.array->at(idx); + } + JSON_CATCH (std::out_of_range&) + { + // create better exception explanation + JSON_THROW(out_of_range::create(401, "array index " + std::to_string(idx) + " is out of range", *this)); + } + } + else + { + JSON_THROW(type_error::create(304, "cannot use at() with " + std::string(type_name()), *this)); + } + } + + /// @brief access specified object element with bounds checking + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/at/ + reference at(const typename object_t::key_type& key) + { + // at only works for objects + if (JSON_HEDLEY_LIKELY(is_object())) + { + JSON_TRY + { + return set_parent(m_value.object->at(key)); + } + JSON_CATCH (std::out_of_range&) + { + // create better exception explanation + JSON_THROW(out_of_range::create(403, "key '" + key + "' not found", *this)); + } + } + else + { + JSON_THROW(type_error::create(304, "cannot use at() with " + std::string(type_name()), *this)); + } + } + + /// @brief access specified object element with bounds checking + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/at/ + const_reference at(const typename object_t::key_type& key) const + { + // at only works for objects + if (JSON_HEDLEY_LIKELY(is_object())) + { + JSON_TRY + { + return m_value.object->at(key); + } + JSON_CATCH (std::out_of_range&) + { + // create better exception explanation + JSON_THROW(out_of_range::create(403, "key '" + key + "' not found", *this)); + } + } + else + { + JSON_THROW(type_error::create(304, "cannot use at() with " + std::string(type_name()), *this)); + } + } + + /// @brief access specified array element + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/operator%5B%5D/ + reference operator[](size_type idx) + { + // implicitly convert null value to an empty array + if (is_null()) + { + m_type = value_t::array; + m_value.array = create(); + assert_invariant(); + } + + // operator[] only works for arrays + if (JSON_HEDLEY_LIKELY(is_array())) + { + // fill up array with null values if given idx is outside range + if (idx >= m_value.array->size()) + { +#if JSON_DIAGNOSTICS + // remember array size & capacity before resizing + const auto old_size = m_value.array->size(); + const auto old_capacity = m_value.array->capacity(); +#endif + m_value.array->resize(idx + 1); + +#if JSON_DIAGNOSTICS + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(m_value.array->capacity() != old_capacity)) + { + // capacity has changed: update all parents + set_parents(); + } + else + { + // set parent for values added above + set_parents(begin() + static_cast(old_size), static_cast(idx + 1 - old_size)); + } +#endif + assert_invariant(); + } + + return m_value.array->operator[](idx); + } + + JSON_THROW(type_error::create(305, "cannot use operator[] with a numeric argument with " + std::string(type_name()), *this)); + } + + /// @brief access specified array element + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/operator%5B%5D/ + const_reference operator[](size_type idx) const + { + // const operator[] only works for arrays + if (JSON_HEDLEY_LIKELY(is_array())) + { + return m_value.array->operator[](idx); + } + + JSON_THROW(type_error::create(305, "cannot use operator[] with a numeric argument with " + std::string(type_name()), *this)); + } + + /// @brief access specified object element + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/operator%5B%5D/ + reference operator[](const typename object_t::key_type& key) + { + // implicitly convert null value to an empty object + if (is_null()) + { + m_type = value_t::object; + m_value.object = create(); + assert_invariant(); + } + + // operator[] only works for objects + if (JSON_HEDLEY_LIKELY(is_object())) + { + return set_parent(m_value.object->operator[](key)); + } + + JSON_THROW(type_error::create(305, "cannot use operator[] with a string argument with " + std::string(type_name()), *this)); + } + + /// @brief access specified object element + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/operator%5B%5D/ + const_reference operator[](const typename object_t::key_type& key) const + { + // const operator[] only works for objects + if (JSON_HEDLEY_LIKELY(is_object())) + { + JSON_ASSERT(m_value.object->find(key) != m_value.object->end()); + return m_value.object->find(key)->second; + } + + JSON_THROW(type_error::create(305, "cannot use operator[] with a string argument with " + std::string(type_name()), *this)); + } + + /// @brief access specified object element + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/operator%5B%5D/ + template + JSON_HEDLEY_NON_NULL(2) + reference operator[](T* key) + { + // implicitly convert null to object + if (is_null()) + { + m_type = value_t::object; + m_value = value_t::object; + assert_invariant(); + } + + // at only works for objects + if (JSON_HEDLEY_LIKELY(is_object())) + { + return set_parent(m_value.object->operator[](key)); + } + + JSON_THROW(type_error::create(305, "cannot use operator[] with a string argument with " + std::string(type_name()), *this)); + } + + /// @brief access specified object element + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/operator%5B%5D/ + template + JSON_HEDLEY_NON_NULL(2) + const_reference operator[](T* key) const + { + // at only works for objects + if (JSON_HEDLEY_LIKELY(is_object())) + { + JSON_ASSERT(m_value.object->find(key) != m_value.object->end()); + return m_value.object->find(key)->second; + } + + JSON_THROW(type_error::create(305, "cannot use operator[] with a string argument with " + std::string(type_name()), *this)); + } + + /// @brief access specified object element with default value + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/value/ + /// using std::is_convertible in a std::enable_if will fail when using explicit conversions + template < class ValueType, typename std::enable_if < + detail::is_getable::value + && !std::is_same::value, int >::type = 0 > + ValueType value(const typename object_t::key_type& key, const ValueType& default_value) const + { + // at only works for objects + if (JSON_HEDLEY_LIKELY(is_object())) + { + // if key is found, return value and given default value otherwise + const auto it = find(key); + if (it != end()) + { + return it->template get(); + } + + return default_value; + } + + JSON_THROW(type_error::create(306, "cannot use value() with " + std::string(type_name()), *this)); + } + + /// @brief access specified object element with default value + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/value/ + /// overload for a default value of type const char* + string_t value(const typename object_t::key_type& key, const char* default_value) const + { + return value(key, string_t(default_value)); + } + + /// @brief access specified object element via JSON Pointer with default value + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/value/ + template::value, int>::type = 0> + ValueType value(const json_pointer& ptr, const ValueType& default_value) const + { + // at only works for objects + if (JSON_HEDLEY_LIKELY(is_object())) + { + // if pointer resolves a value, return it or use default value + JSON_TRY + { + return ptr.get_checked(this).template get(); + } + JSON_INTERNAL_CATCH (out_of_range&) + { + return default_value; + } + } + + JSON_THROW(type_error::create(306, "cannot use value() with " + std::string(type_name()), *this)); + } + + /// @brief access specified object element via JSON Pointer with default value + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/value/ + /// overload for a default value of type const char* + JSON_HEDLEY_NON_NULL(3) + string_t value(const json_pointer& ptr, const char* default_value) const + { + return value(ptr, string_t(default_value)); + } + + /// @brief access the first element + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/front/ + reference front() + { + return *begin(); + } + + /// @brief access the first element + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/front/ + const_reference front() const + { + return *cbegin(); + } + + /// @brief access the last element + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/back/ + reference back() + { + auto tmp = end(); + --tmp; + return *tmp; + } + + /// @brief access the last element + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/back/ + const_reference back() const + { + auto tmp = cend(); + --tmp; + return *tmp; + } + + /// @brief remove element given an iterator + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/erase/ + template < class IteratorType, typename std::enable_if < + std::is_same::value || + std::is_same::value, int >::type + = 0 > + IteratorType erase(IteratorType pos) + { + // make sure iterator fits the current value + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(this != pos.m_object)) + { + JSON_THROW(invalid_iterator::create(202, "iterator does not fit current value", *this)); + } + + IteratorType result = end(); + + switch (m_type) + { + case value_t::boolean: + case value_t::number_float: + case value_t::number_integer: + case value_t::number_unsigned: + case value_t::string: + case value_t::binary: + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!pos.m_it.primitive_iterator.is_begin())) + { + JSON_THROW(invalid_iterator::create(205, "iterator out of range", *this)); + } + + if (is_string()) + { + AllocatorType alloc; + std::allocator_traits::destroy(alloc, m_value.string); + std::allocator_traits::deallocate(alloc, m_value.string, 1); + m_value.string = nullptr; + } + else if (is_binary()) + { + AllocatorType alloc; + std::allocator_traits::destroy(alloc, m_value.binary); + std::allocator_traits::deallocate(alloc, m_value.binary, 1); + m_value.binary = nullptr; + } + + m_type = value_t::null; + assert_invariant(); + break; + } + + case value_t::object: + { + result.m_it.object_iterator = m_value.object->erase(pos.m_it.object_iterator); + break; + } + + case value_t::array: + { + result.m_it.array_iterator = m_value.array->erase(pos.m_it.array_iterator); + break; + } + + case value_t::null: + case value_t::discarded: + default: + JSON_THROW(type_error::create(307, "cannot use erase() with " + std::string(type_name()), *this)); + } + + return result; + } + + /// @brief remove elements given an iterator range + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/erase/ + template < class IteratorType, typename std::enable_if < + std::is_same::value || + std::is_same::value, int >::type + = 0 > + IteratorType erase(IteratorType first, IteratorType last) + { + // make sure iterator fits the current value + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(this != first.m_object || this != last.m_object)) + { + JSON_THROW(invalid_iterator::create(203, "iterators do not fit current value", *this)); + } + + IteratorType result = end(); + + switch (m_type) + { + case value_t::boolean: + case value_t::number_float: + case value_t::number_integer: + case value_t::number_unsigned: + case value_t::string: + case value_t::binary: + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_LIKELY(!first.m_it.primitive_iterator.is_begin() + || !last.m_it.primitive_iterator.is_end())) + { + JSON_THROW(invalid_iterator::create(204, "iterators out of range", *this)); + } + + if (is_string()) + { + AllocatorType alloc; + std::allocator_traits::destroy(alloc, m_value.string); + std::allocator_traits::deallocate(alloc, m_value.string, 1); + m_value.string = nullptr; + } + else if (is_binary()) + { + AllocatorType alloc; + std::allocator_traits::destroy(alloc, m_value.binary); + std::allocator_traits::deallocate(alloc, m_value.binary, 1); + m_value.binary = nullptr; + } + + m_type = value_t::null; + assert_invariant(); + break; + } + + case value_t::object: + { + result.m_it.object_iterator = m_value.object->erase(first.m_it.object_iterator, + last.m_it.object_iterator); + break; + } + + case value_t::array: + { + result.m_it.array_iterator = m_value.array->erase(first.m_it.array_iterator, + last.m_it.array_iterator); + break; + } + + case value_t::null: + case value_t::discarded: + default: + JSON_THROW(type_error::create(307, "cannot use erase() with " + std::string(type_name()), *this)); + } + + return result; + } + + /// @brief remove element from a JSON object given a key + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/erase/ + size_type erase(const typename object_t::key_type& key) + { + // this erase only works for objects + if (JSON_HEDLEY_LIKELY(is_object())) + { + return m_value.object->erase(key); + } + + JSON_THROW(type_error::create(307, "cannot use erase() with " + std::string(type_name()), *this)); + } + + /// @brief remove element from a JSON array given an index + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/erase/ + void erase(const size_type idx) + { + // this erase only works for arrays + if (JSON_HEDLEY_LIKELY(is_array())) + { + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(idx >= size())) + { + JSON_THROW(out_of_range::create(401, "array index " + std::to_string(idx) + " is out of range", *this)); + } + + m_value.array->erase(m_value.array->begin() + static_cast(idx)); + } + else + { + JSON_THROW(type_error::create(307, "cannot use erase() with " + std::string(type_name()), *this)); + } + } + + /// @} + + + //////////// + // lookup // + //////////// + + /// @name lookup + /// @{ + + /// @brief find an element in a JSON object + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/find/ + template + iterator find(KeyT&& key) + { + auto result = end(); + + if (is_object()) + { + result.m_it.object_iterator = m_value.object->find(std::forward(key)); + } + + return result; + } + + /// @brief find an element in a JSON object + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/find/ + template + const_iterator find(KeyT&& key) const + { + auto result = cend(); + + if (is_object()) + { + result.m_it.object_iterator = m_value.object->find(std::forward(key)); + } + + return result; + } + + /// @brief returns the number of occurrences of a key in a JSON object + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/count/ + template + size_type count(KeyT&& key) const + { + // return 0 for all nonobject types + return is_object() ? m_value.object->count(std::forward(key)) : 0; + } + + /// @brief check the existence of an element in a JSON object + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/contains/ + template < typename KeyT, typename std::enable_if < + !std::is_same::type, json_pointer>::value, int >::type = 0 > + bool contains(KeyT && key) const + { + return is_object() && m_value.object->find(std::forward(key)) != m_value.object->end(); + } + + /// @brief check the existence of an element in a JSON object given a JSON pointer + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/contains/ + bool contains(const json_pointer& ptr) const + { + return ptr.contains(this); + } + + /// @} + + + /////////////// + // iterators // + /////////////// + + /// @name iterators + /// @{ + + /// @brief returns an iterator to the first element + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/begin/ + iterator begin() noexcept + { + iterator result(this); + result.set_begin(); + return result; + } + + /// @brief returns an iterator to the first element + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/begin/ + const_iterator begin() const noexcept + { + return cbegin(); + } + + /// @brief returns a const iterator to the first element + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/cbegin/ + const_iterator cbegin() const noexcept + { + const_iterator result(this); + result.set_begin(); + return result; + } + + /// @brief returns an iterator to one past the last element + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/end/ + iterator end() noexcept + { + iterator result(this); + result.set_end(); + return result; + } + + /// @brief returns an iterator to one past the last element + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/end/ + const_iterator end() const noexcept + { + return cend(); + } + + /// @brief returns an iterator to one past the last element + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/cend/ + const_iterator cend() const noexcept + { + const_iterator result(this); + result.set_end(); + return result; + } + + /// @brief returns an iterator to the reverse-beginning + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/rbegin/ + reverse_iterator rbegin() noexcept + { + return reverse_iterator(end()); + } + + /// @brief returns an iterator to the reverse-beginning + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/rbegin/ + const_reverse_iterator rbegin() const noexcept + { + return crbegin(); + } + + /// @brief returns an iterator to the reverse-end + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/rend/ + reverse_iterator rend() noexcept + { + return reverse_iterator(begin()); + } + + /// @brief returns an iterator to the reverse-end + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/rend/ + const_reverse_iterator rend() const noexcept + { + return crend(); + } + + /// @brief returns a const reverse iterator to the last element + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/crbegin/ + const_reverse_iterator crbegin() const noexcept + { + return const_reverse_iterator(cend()); + } + + /// @brief returns a const reverse iterator to one before the first + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/crend/ + const_reverse_iterator crend() const noexcept + { + return const_reverse_iterator(cbegin()); + } + + public: + /// @brief wrapper to access iterator member functions in range-based for + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/items/ + /// @deprecated This function is deprecated since 3.1.0 and will be removed in + /// version 4.0.0 of the library. Please use @ref items() instead; + /// that is, replace `json::iterator_wrapper(j)` with `j.items()`. + JSON_HEDLEY_DEPRECATED_FOR(3.1.0, items()) + static iteration_proxy iterator_wrapper(reference ref) noexcept + { + return ref.items(); + } + + /// @brief wrapper to access iterator member functions in range-based for + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/items/ + /// @deprecated This function is deprecated since 3.1.0 and will be removed in + /// version 4.0.0 of the library. Please use @ref items() instead; + /// that is, replace `json::iterator_wrapper(j)` with `j.items()`. + JSON_HEDLEY_DEPRECATED_FOR(3.1.0, items()) + static iteration_proxy iterator_wrapper(const_reference ref) noexcept + { + return ref.items(); + } + + /// @brief helper to access iterator member functions in range-based for + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/items/ + iteration_proxy items() noexcept + { + return iteration_proxy(*this); + } + + /// @brief helper to access iterator member functions in range-based for + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/items/ + iteration_proxy items() const noexcept + { + return iteration_proxy(*this); + } + + /// @} + + + ////////////// + // capacity // + ////////////// + + /// @name capacity + /// @{ + + /// @brief checks whether the container is empty. + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/empty/ + bool empty() const noexcept + { + switch (m_type) + { + case value_t::null: + { + // null values are empty + return true; + } + + case value_t::array: + { + // delegate call to array_t::empty() + return m_value.array->empty(); + } + + case value_t::object: + { + // delegate call to object_t::empty() + return m_value.object->empty(); + } + + case value_t::string: + case value_t::boolean: + case value_t::number_integer: + case value_t::number_unsigned: + case value_t::number_float: + case value_t::binary: + case value_t::discarded: + default: + { + // all other types are nonempty + return false; + } + } + } + + /// @brief returns the number of elements + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/size/ + size_type size() const noexcept + { + switch (m_type) + { + case value_t::null: + { + // null values are empty + return 0; + } + + case value_t::array: + { + // delegate call to array_t::size() + return m_value.array->size(); + } + + case value_t::object: + { + // delegate call to object_t::size() + return m_value.object->size(); + } + + case value_t::string: + case value_t::boolean: + case value_t::number_integer: + case value_t::number_unsigned: + case value_t::number_float: + case value_t::binary: + case value_t::discarded: + default: + { + // all other types have size 1 + return 1; + } + } + } + + /// @brief returns the maximum possible number of elements + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/max_size/ + size_type max_size() const noexcept + { + switch (m_type) + { + case value_t::array: + { + // delegate call to array_t::max_size() + return m_value.array->max_size(); + } + + case value_t::object: + { + // delegate call to object_t::max_size() + return m_value.object->max_size(); + } + + case value_t::null: + case value_t::string: + case value_t::boolean: + case value_t::number_integer: + case value_t::number_unsigned: + case value_t::number_float: + case value_t::binary: + case value_t::discarded: + default: + { + // all other types have max_size() == size() + return size(); + } + } + } + + /// @} + + + /////////////// + // modifiers // + /////////////// + + /// @name modifiers + /// @{ + + /// @brief clears the contents + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/clear/ + void clear() noexcept + { + switch (m_type) + { + case value_t::number_integer: + { + m_value.number_integer = 0; + break; + } + + case value_t::number_unsigned: + { + m_value.number_unsigned = 0; + break; + } + + case value_t::number_float: + { + m_value.number_float = 0.0; + break; + } + + case value_t::boolean: + { + m_value.boolean = false; + break; + } + + case value_t::string: + { + m_value.string->clear(); + break; + } + + case value_t::binary: + { + m_value.binary->clear(); + break; + } + + case value_t::array: + { + m_value.array->clear(); + break; + } + + case value_t::object: + { + m_value.object->clear(); + break; + } + + case value_t::null: + case value_t::discarded: + default: + break; + } + } + + /// @brief add an object to an array + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/push_back/ + void push_back(basic_json&& val) + { + // push_back only works for null objects or arrays + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!(is_null() || is_array()))) + { + JSON_THROW(type_error::create(308, "cannot use push_back() with " + std::string(type_name()), *this)); + } + + // transform null object into an array + if (is_null()) + { + m_type = value_t::array; + m_value = value_t::array; + assert_invariant(); + } + + // add element to array (move semantics) + const auto old_capacity = m_value.array->capacity(); + m_value.array->push_back(std::move(val)); + set_parent(m_value.array->back(), old_capacity); + // if val is moved from, basic_json move constructor marks it null, so we do not call the destructor + } + + /// @brief add an object to an array + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/operator+=/ + reference operator+=(basic_json&& val) + { + push_back(std::move(val)); + return *this; + } + + /// @brief add an object to an array + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/push_back/ + void push_back(const basic_json& val) + { + // push_back only works for null objects or arrays + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!(is_null() || is_array()))) + { + JSON_THROW(type_error::create(308, "cannot use push_back() with " + std::string(type_name()), *this)); + } + + // transform null object into an array + if (is_null()) + { + m_type = value_t::array; + m_value = value_t::array; + assert_invariant(); + } + + // add element to array + const auto old_capacity = m_value.array->capacity(); + m_value.array->push_back(val); + set_parent(m_value.array->back(), old_capacity); + } + + /// @brief add an object to an array + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/operator+=/ + reference operator+=(const basic_json& val) + { + push_back(val); + return *this; + } + + /// @brief add an object to an object + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/push_back/ + void push_back(const typename object_t::value_type& val) + { + // push_back only works for null objects or objects + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!(is_null() || is_object()))) + { + JSON_THROW(type_error::create(308, "cannot use push_back() with " + std::string(type_name()), *this)); + } + + // transform null object into an object + if (is_null()) + { + m_type = value_t::object; + m_value = value_t::object; + assert_invariant(); + } + + // add element to object + auto res = m_value.object->insert(val); + set_parent(res.first->second); + } + + /// @brief add an object to an object + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/operator+=/ + reference operator+=(const typename object_t::value_type& val) + { + push_back(val); + return *this; + } + + /// @brief add an object to an object + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/push_back/ + void push_back(initializer_list_t init) + { + if (is_object() && init.size() == 2 && (*init.begin())->is_string()) + { + basic_json&& key = init.begin()->moved_or_copied(); + push_back(typename object_t::value_type( + std::move(key.get_ref()), (init.begin() + 1)->moved_or_copied())); + } + else + { + push_back(basic_json(init)); + } + } + + /// @brief add an object to an object + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/operator+=/ + reference operator+=(initializer_list_t init) + { + push_back(init); + return *this; + } + + /// @brief add an object to an array + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/emplace_back/ + template + reference emplace_back(Args&& ... args) + { + // emplace_back only works for null objects or arrays + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!(is_null() || is_array()))) + { + JSON_THROW(type_error::create(311, "cannot use emplace_back() with " + std::string(type_name()), *this)); + } + + // transform null object into an array + if (is_null()) + { + m_type = value_t::array; + m_value = value_t::array; + assert_invariant(); + } + + // add element to array (perfect forwarding) + const auto old_capacity = m_value.array->capacity(); + m_value.array->emplace_back(std::forward(args)...); + return set_parent(m_value.array->back(), old_capacity); + } + + /// @brief add an object to an object if key does not exist + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/emplace/ + template + std::pair emplace(Args&& ... args) + { + // emplace only works for null objects or arrays + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!(is_null() || is_object()))) + { + JSON_THROW(type_error::create(311, "cannot use emplace() with " + std::string(type_name()), *this)); + } + + // transform null object into an object + if (is_null()) + { + m_type = value_t::object; + m_value = value_t::object; + assert_invariant(); + } + + // add element to array (perfect forwarding) + auto res = m_value.object->emplace(std::forward(args)...); + set_parent(res.first->second); + + // create result iterator and set iterator to the result of emplace + auto it = begin(); + it.m_it.object_iterator = res.first; + + // return pair of iterator and boolean + return {it, res.second}; + } + + /// Helper for insertion of an iterator + /// @note: This uses std::distance to support GCC 4.8, + /// see https://github.com/nlohmann/json/pull/1257 + template + iterator insert_iterator(const_iterator pos, Args&& ... args) + { + iterator result(this); + JSON_ASSERT(m_value.array != nullptr); + + auto insert_pos = std::distance(m_value.array->begin(), pos.m_it.array_iterator); + m_value.array->insert(pos.m_it.array_iterator, std::forward(args)...); + result.m_it.array_iterator = m_value.array->begin() + insert_pos; + + // This could have been written as: + // result.m_it.array_iterator = m_value.array->insert(pos.m_it.array_iterator, cnt, val); + // but the return value of insert is missing in GCC 4.8, so it is written this way instead. + + set_parents(); + return result; + } + + /// @brief inserts element into array + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/insert/ + iterator insert(const_iterator pos, const basic_json& val) + { + // insert only works for arrays + if (JSON_HEDLEY_LIKELY(is_array())) + { + // check if iterator pos fits to this JSON value + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(pos.m_object != this)) + { + JSON_THROW(invalid_iterator::create(202, "iterator does not fit current value", *this)); + } + + // insert to array and return iterator + return insert_iterator(pos, val); + } + + JSON_THROW(type_error::create(309, "cannot use insert() with " + std::string(type_name()), *this)); + } + + /// @brief inserts element into array + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/insert/ + iterator insert(const_iterator pos, basic_json&& val) + { + return insert(pos, val); + } + + /// @brief inserts copies of element into array + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/insert/ + iterator insert(const_iterator pos, size_type cnt, const basic_json& val) + { + // insert only works for arrays + if (JSON_HEDLEY_LIKELY(is_array())) + { + // check if iterator pos fits to this JSON value + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(pos.m_object != this)) + { + JSON_THROW(invalid_iterator::create(202, "iterator does not fit current value", *this)); + } + + // insert to array and return iterator + return insert_iterator(pos, cnt, val); + } + + JSON_THROW(type_error::create(309, "cannot use insert() with " + std::string(type_name()), *this)); + } + + /// @brief inserts range of elements into array + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/insert/ + iterator insert(const_iterator pos, const_iterator first, const_iterator last) + { + // insert only works for arrays + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!is_array())) + { + JSON_THROW(type_error::create(309, "cannot use insert() with " + std::string(type_name()), *this)); + } + + // check if iterator pos fits to this JSON value + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(pos.m_object != this)) + { + JSON_THROW(invalid_iterator::create(202, "iterator does not fit current value", *this)); + } + + // check if range iterators belong to the same JSON object + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(first.m_object != last.m_object)) + { + JSON_THROW(invalid_iterator::create(210, "iterators do not fit", *this)); + } + + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(first.m_object == this)) + { + JSON_THROW(invalid_iterator::create(211, "passed iterators may not belong to container", *this)); + } + + // insert to array and return iterator + return insert_iterator(pos, first.m_it.array_iterator, last.m_it.array_iterator); + } + + /// @brief inserts elements from initializer list into array + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/insert/ + iterator insert(const_iterator pos, initializer_list_t ilist) + { + // insert only works for arrays + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!is_array())) + { + JSON_THROW(type_error::create(309, "cannot use insert() with " + std::string(type_name()), *this)); + } + + // check if iterator pos fits to this JSON value + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(pos.m_object != this)) + { + JSON_THROW(invalid_iterator::create(202, "iterator does not fit current value", *this)); + } + + // insert to array and return iterator + return insert_iterator(pos, ilist.begin(), ilist.end()); + } + + /// @brief inserts range of elements into object + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/insert/ + void insert(const_iterator first, const_iterator last) + { + // insert only works for objects + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!is_object())) + { + JSON_THROW(type_error::create(309, "cannot use insert() with " + std::string(type_name()), *this)); + } + + // check if range iterators belong to the same JSON object + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(first.m_object != last.m_object)) + { + JSON_THROW(invalid_iterator::create(210, "iterators do not fit", *this)); + } + + // passed iterators must belong to objects + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!first.m_object->is_object())) + { + JSON_THROW(invalid_iterator::create(202, "iterators first and last must point to objects", *this)); + } + + m_value.object->insert(first.m_it.object_iterator, last.m_it.object_iterator); + } + + /// @brief updates a JSON object from another object, overwriting existing keys + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/update/ + void update(const_reference j, bool merge_objects = false) + { + update(j.begin(), j.end(), merge_objects); + } + + /// @brief updates a JSON object from another object, overwriting existing keys + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/update/ + void update(const_iterator first, const_iterator last, bool merge_objects = false) + { + // implicitly convert null value to an empty object + if (is_null()) + { + m_type = value_t::object; + m_value.object = create(); + assert_invariant(); + } + + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!is_object())) + { + JSON_THROW(type_error::create(312, "cannot use update() with " + std::string(type_name()), *this)); + } + + // check if range iterators belong to the same JSON object + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(first.m_object != last.m_object)) + { + JSON_THROW(invalid_iterator::create(210, "iterators do not fit", *this)); + } + + // passed iterators must belong to objects + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!first.m_object->is_object())) + { + JSON_THROW(type_error::create(312, "cannot use update() with " + std::string(first.m_object->type_name()), *first.m_object)); + } + + for (auto it = first; it != last; ++it) + { + if (merge_objects && it.value().is_object()) + { + auto it2 = m_value.object->find(it.key()); + if (it2 != m_value.object->end()) + { + it2->second.update(it.value(), true); + continue; + } + } + m_value.object->operator[](it.key()) = it.value(); +#if JSON_DIAGNOSTICS + m_value.object->operator[](it.key()).m_parent = this; +#endif + } + } + + /// @brief exchanges the values + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/swap/ + void swap(reference other) noexcept ( + std::is_nothrow_move_constructible::value&& + std::is_nothrow_move_assignable::value&& + std::is_nothrow_move_constructible::value&& + std::is_nothrow_move_assignable::value + ) + { + std::swap(m_type, other.m_type); + std::swap(m_value, other.m_value); + + set_parents(); + other.set_parents(); + assert_invariant(); + } + + /// @brief exchanges the values + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/swap/ + friend void swap(reference left, reference right) noexcept ( + std::is_nothrow_move_constructible::value&& + std::is_nothrow_move_assignable::value&& + std::is_nothrow_move_constructible::value&& + std::is_nothrow_move_assignable::value + ) + { + left.swap(right); + } + + /// @brief exchanges the values + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/swap/ + void swap(array_t& other) // NOLINT(bugprone-exception-escape) + { + // swap only works for arrays + if (JSON_HEDLEY_LIKELY(is_array())) + { + std::swap(*(m_value.array), other); + } + else + { + JSON_THROW(type_error::create(310, "cannot use swap() with " + std::string(type_name()), *this)); + } + } + + /// @brief exchanges the values + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/swap/ + void swap(object_t& other) // NOLINT(bugprone-exception-escape) + { + // swap only works for objects + if (JSON_HEDLEY_LIKELY(is_object())) + { + std::swap(*(m_value.object), other); + } + else + { + JSON_THROW(type_error::create(310, "cannot use swap() with " + std::string(type_name()), *this)); + } + } + + /// @brief exchanges the values + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/swap/ + void swap(string_t& other) // NOLINT(bugprone-exception-escape) + { + // swap only works for strings + if (JSON_HEDLEY_LIKELY(is_string())) + { + std::swap(*(m_value.string), other); + } + else + { + JSON_THROW(type_error::create(310, "cannot use swap() with " + std::string(type_name()), *this)); + } + } + + /// @brief exchanges the values + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/swap/ + void swap(binary_t& other) // NOLINT(bugprone-exception-escape) + { + // swap only works for strings + if (JSON_HEDLEY_LIKELY(is_binary())) + { + std::swap(*(m_value.binary), other); + } + else + { + JSON_THROW(type_error::create(310, "cannot use swap() with " + std::string(type_name()), *this)); + } + } + + /// @brief exchanges the values + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/swap/ + void swap(typename binary_t::container_type& other) // NOLINT(bugprone-exception-escape) + { + // swap only works for strings + if (JSON_HEDLEY_LIKELY(is_binary())) + { + std::swap(*(m_value.binary), other); + } + else + { + JSON_THROW(type_error::create(310, "cannot use swap() with " + std::string(type_name()), *this)); + } + } + + /// @} + + public: + ////////////////////////////////////////// + // lexicographical comparison operators // + ////////////////////////////////////////// + + /// @name lexicographical comparison operators + /// @{ + + /// @brief comparison: equal + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/operator_eq/ + friend bool operator==(const_reference lhs, const_reference rhs) noexcept + { +#ifdef __GNUC__ +#pragma GCC diagnostic push +#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wfloat-equal" +#endif + const auto lhs_type = lhs.type(); + const auto rhs_type = rhs.type(); + + if (lhs_type == rhs_type) + { + switch (lhs_type) + { + case value_t::array: + return *lhs.m_value.array == *rhs.m_value.array; + + case value_t::object: + return *lhs.m_value.object == *rhs.m_value.object; + + case value_t::null: + return true; + + case value_t::string: + return *lhs.m_value.string == *rhs.m_value.string; + + case value_t::boolean: + return lhs.m_value.boolean == rhs.m_value.boolean; + + case value_t::number_integer: + return lhs.m_value.number_integer == rhs.m_value.number_integer; + + case value_t::number_unsigned: + return lhs.m_value.number_unsigned == rhs.m_value.number_unsigned; + + case value_t::number_float: + return lhs.m_value.number_float == rhs.m_value.number_float; + + case value_t::binary: + return *lhs.m_value.binary == *rhs.m_value.binary; + + case value_t::discarded: + default: + return false; + } + } + else if (lhs_type == value_t::number_integer && rhs_type == value_t::number_float) + { + return static_cast(lhs.m_value.number_integer) == rhs.m_value.number_float; + } + else if (lhs_type == value_t::number_float && rhs_type == value_t::number_integer) + { + return lhs.m_value.number_float == static_cast(rhs.m_value.number_integer); + } + else if (lhs_type == value_t::number_unsigned && rhs_type == value_t::number_float) + { + return static_cast(lhs.m_value.number_unsigned) == rhs.m_value.number_float; + } + else if (lhs_type == value_t::number_float && rhs_type == value_t::number_unsigned) + { + return lhs.m_value.number_float == static_cast(rhs.m_value.number_unsigned); + } + else if (lhs_type == value_t::number_unsigned && rhs_type == value_t::number_integer) + { + return static_cast(lhs.m_value.number_unsigned) == rhs.m_value.number_integer; + } + else if (lhs_type == value_t::number_integer && rhs_type == value_t::number_unsigned) + { + return lhs.m_value.number_integer == static_cast(rhs.m_value.number_unsigned); + } + + return false; +#ifdef __GNUC__ +#pragma GCC diagnostic pop +#endif + } + + /// @brief comparison: equal + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/operator_eq/ + template::value, int>::type = 0> + friend bool operator==(const_reference lhs, ScalarType rhs) noexcept + { + return lhs == basic_json(rhs); + } + + /// @brief comparison: equal + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/operator_eq/ + template::value, int>::type = 0> + friend bool operator==(ScalarType lhs, const_reference rhs) noexcept + { + return basic_json(lhs) == rhs; + } + + /// @brief comparison: not equal + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/operator_ne/ + friend bool operator!=(const_reference lhs, const_reference rhs) noexcept + { + return !(lhs == rhs); + } + + /// @brief comparison: not equal + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/operator_ne/ + template::value, int>::type = 0> + friend bool operator!=(const_reference lhs, ScalarType rhs) noexcept + { + return lhs != basic_json(rhs); + } + + /// @brief comparison: not equal + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/operator_ne/ + template::value, int>::type = 0> + friend bool operator!=(ScalarType lhs, const_reference rhs) noexcept + { + return basic_json(lhs) != rhs; + } + + /// @brief comparison: less than + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/operator_lt/ + friend bool operator<(const_reference lhs, const_reference rhs) noexcept + { + const auto lhs_type = lhs.type(); + const auto rhs_type = rhs.type(); + + if (lhs_type == rhs_type) + { + switch (lhs_type) + { + case value_t::array: + // note parentheses are necessary, see + // https://github.com/nlohmann/json/issues/1530 + return (*lhs.m_value.array) < (*rhs.m_value.array); + + case value_t::object: + return (*lhs.m_value.object) < (*rhs.m_value.object); + + case value_t::null: + return false; + + case value_t::string: + return (*lhs.m_value.string) < (*rhs.m_value.string); + + case value_t::boolean: + return (lhs.m_value.boolean) < (rhs.m_value.boolean); + + case value_t::number_integer: + return (lhs.m_value.number_integer) < (rhs.m_value.number_integer); + + case value_t::number_unsigned: + return (lhs.m_value.number_unsigned) < (rhs.m_value.number_unsigned); + + case value_t::number_float: + return (lhs.m_value.number_float) < (rhs.m_value.number_float); + + case value_t::binary: + return (*lhs.m_value.binary) < (*rhs.m_value.binary); + + case value_t::discarded: + default: + return false; + } + } + else if (lhs_type == value_t::number_integer && rhs_type == value_t::number_float) + { + return static_cast(lhs.m_value.number_integer) < rhs.m_value.number_float; + } + else if (lhs_type == value_t::number_float && rhs_type == value_t::number_integer) + { + return lhs.m_value.number_float < static_cast(rhs.m_value.number_integer); + } + else if (lhs_type == value_t::number_unsigned && rhs_type == value_t::number_float) + { + return static_cast(lhs.m_value.number_unsigned) < rhs.m_value.number_float; + } + else if (lhs_type == value_t::number_float && rhs_type == value_t::number_unsigned) + { + return lhs.m_value.number_float < static_cast(rhs.m_value.number_unsigned); + } + else if (lhs_type == value_t::number_integer && rhs_type == value_t::number_unsigned) + { + return lhs.m_value.number_integer < static_cast(rhs.m_value.number_unsigned); + } + else if (lhs_type == value_t::number_unsigned && rhs_type == value_t::number_integer) + { + return static_cast(lhs.m_value.number_unsigned) < rhs.m_value.number_integer; + } + + // We only reach this line if we cannot compare values. In that case, + // we compare types. Note we have to call the operator explicitly, + // because MSVC has problems otherwise. + return operator<(lhs_type, rhs_type); + } + + /// @brief comparison: less than + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/operator_lt/ + template::value, int>::type = 0> + friend bool operator<(const_reference lhs, ScalarType rhs) noexcept + { + return lhs < basic_json(rhs); + } + + /// @brief comparison: less than + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/operator_lt/ + template::value, int>::type = 0> + friend bool operator<(ScalarType lhs, const_reference rhs) noexcept + { + return basic_json(lhs) < rhs; + } + + /// @brief comparison: less than or equal + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/operator_le/ + friend bool operator<=(const_reference lhs, const_reference rhs) noexcept + { + return !(rhs < lhs); + } + + /// @brief comparison: less than or equal + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/operator_le/ + template::value, int>::type = 0> + friend bool operator<=(const_reference lhs, ScalarType rhs) noexcept + { + return lhs <= basic_json(rhs); + } + + /// @brief comparison: less than or equal + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/operator_le/ + template::value, int>::type = 0> + friend bool operator<=(ScalarType lhs, const_reference rhs) noexcept + { + return basic_json(lhs) <= rhs; + } + + /// @brief comparison: greater than + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/operator_gt/ + friend bool operator>(const_reference lhs, const_reference rhs) noexcept + { + return !(lhs <= rhs); + } + + /// @brief comparison: greater than + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/operator_gt/ + template::value, int>::type = 0> + friend bool operator>(const_reference lhs, ScalarType rhs) noexcept + { + return lhs > basic_json(rhs); + } + + /// @brief comparison: greater than + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/operator_gt/ + template::value, int>::type = 0> + friend bool operator>(ScalarType lhs, const_reference rhs) noexcept + { + return basic_json(lhs) > rhs; + } + + /// @brief comparison: greater than or equal + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/operator_ge/ + friend bool operator>=(const_reference lhs, const_reference rhs) noexcept + { + return !(lhs < rhs); + } + + /// @brief comparison: greater than or equal + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/operator_ge/ + template::value, int>::type = 0> + friend bool operator>=(const_reference lhs, ScalarType rhs) noexcept + { + return lhs >= basic_json(rhs); + } + + /// @brief comparison: greater than or equal + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/operator_ge/ + template::value, int>::type = 0> + friend bool operator>=(ScalarType lhs, const_reference rhs) noexcept + { + return basic_json(lhs) >= rhs; + } + + /// @} + + /////////////////// + // serialization // + /////////////////// + + /// @name serialization + /// @{ +#ifndef JSON_NO_IO + /// @brief serialize to stream + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/operator_ltlt/ + friend std::ostream& operator<<(std::ostream& o, const basic_json& j) + { + // read width member and use it as indentation parameter if nonzero + const bool pretty_print = o.width() > 0; + const auto indentation = pretty_print ? o.width() : 0; + + // reset width to 0 for subsequent calls to this stream + o.width(0); + + // do the actual serialization + serializer s(detail::output_adapter(o), o.fill()); + s.dump(j, pretty_print, false, static_cast(indentation)); + return o; + } + + /// @brief serialize to stream + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/operator_ltlt/ + /// @deprecated This function is deprecated since 3.0.0 and will be removed in + /// version 4.0.0 of the library. Please use + /// operator<<(std::ostream&, const basic_json&) instead; that is, + /// replace calls like `j >> o;` with `o << j;`. + JSON_HEDLEY_DEPRECATED_FOR(3.0.0, operator<<(std::ostream&, const basic_json&)) + friend std::ostream& operator>>(const basic_json& j, std::ostream& o) + { + return o << j; + } +#endif // JSON_NO_IO + /// @} + + + ///////////////////// + // deserialization // + ///////////////////// + + /// @name deserialization + /// @{ + + /// @brief deserialize from a compatible input + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/parse/ + template + JSON_HEDLEY_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT + static basic_json parse(InputType&& i, + const parser_callback_t cb = nullptr, + const bool allow_exceptions = true, + const bool ignore_comments = false) + { + basic_json result; + parser(detail::input_adapter(std::forward(i)), cb, allow_exceptions, ignore_comments).parse(true, result); + return result; + } + + /// @brief deserialize from a pair of character iterators + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/parse/ + template + JSON_HEDLEY_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT + static basic_json parse(IteratorType first, + IteratorType last, + const parser_callback_t cb = nullptr, + const bool allow_exceptions = true, + const bool ignore_comments = false) + { + basic_json result; + parser(detail::input_adapter(std::move(first), std::move(last)), cb, allow_exceptions, ignore_comments).parse(true, result); + return result; + } + + JSON_HEDLEY_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT + JSON_HEDLEY_DEPRECATED_FOR(3.8.0, parse(ptr, ptr + len)) + static basic_json parse(detail::span_input_adapter&& i, + const parser_callback_t cb = nullptr, + const bool allow_exceptions = true, + const bool ignore_comments = false) + { + basic_json result; + parser(i.get(), cb, allow_exceptions, ignore_comments).parse(true, result); + return result; + } + + /// @brief check if the input is valid JSON + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/accept/ + template + static bool accept(InputType&& i, + const bool ignore_comments = false) + { + return parser(detail::input_adapter(std::forward(i)), nullptr, false, ignore_comments).accept(true); + } + + /// @brief check if the input is valid JSON + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/accept/ + template + static bool accept(IteratorType first, IteratorType last, + const bool ignore_comments = false) + { + return parser(detail::input_adapter(std::move(first), std::move(last)), nullptr, false, ignore_comments).accept(true); + } + + JSON_HEDLEY_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT + JSON_HEDLEY_DEPRECATED_FOR(3.8.0, accept(ptr, ptr + len)) + static bool accept(detail::span_input_adapter&& i, + const bool ignore_comments = false) + { + return parser(i.get(), nullptr, false, ignore_comments).accept(true); + } + + /// @brief generate SAX events + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/sax_parse/ + template + JSON_HEDLEY_NON_NULL(2) + static bool sax_parse(InputType&& i, SAX* sax, + input_format_t format = input_format_t::json, + const bool strict = true, + const bool ignore_comments = false) + { + auto ia = detail::input_adapter(std::forward(i)); + return format == input_format_t::json + ? parser(std::move(ia), nullptr, true, ignore_comments).sax_parse(sax, strict) + : detail::binary_reader(std::move(ia)).sax_parse(format, sax, strict); + } + + /// @brief generate SAX events + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/sax_parse/ + template + JSON_HEDLEY_NON_NULL(3) + static bool sax_parse(IteratorType first, IteratorType last, SAX* sax, + input_format_t format = input_format_t::json, + const bool strict = true, + const bool ignore_comments = false) + { + auto ia = detail::input_adapter(std::move(first), std::move(last)); + return format == input_format_t::json + ? parser(std::move(ia), nullptr, true, ignore_comments).sax_parse(sax, strict) + : detail::binary_reader(std::move(ia)).sax_parse(format, sax, strict); + } + + /// @brief generate SAX events + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/sax_parse/ + /// @deprecated This function is deprecated since 3.8.0 and will be removed in + /// version 4.0.0 of the library. Please use + /// sax_parse(ptr, ptr + len) instead. + template + JSON_HEDLEY_DEPRECATED_FOR(3.8.0, sax_parse(ptr, ptr + len, ...)) + JSON_HEDLEY_NON_NULL(2) + static bool sax_parse(detail::span_input_adapter&& i, SAX* sax, + input_format_t format = input_format_t::json, + const bool strict = true, + const bool ignore_comments = false) + { + auto ia = i.get(); + return format == input_format_t::json + // NOLINTNEXTLINE(hicpp-move-const-arg,performance-move-const-arg) + ? parser(std::move(ia), nullptr, true, ignore_comments).sax_parse(sax, strict) + // NOLINTNEXTLINE(hicpp-move-const-arg,performance-move-const-arg) + : detail::binary_reader(std::move(ia)).sax_parse(format, sax, strict); + } +#ifndef JSON_NO_IO + /// @brief deserialize from stream + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/operator_gtgt/ + /// @deprecated This stream operator is deprecated since 3.0.0 and will be removed in + /// version 4.0.0 of the library. Please use + /// operator>>(std::istream&, basic_json&) instead; that is, + /// replace calls like `j << i;` with `i >> j;`. + JSON_HEDLEY_DEPRECATED_FOR(3.0.0, operator>>(std::istream&, basic_json&)) + friend std::istream& operator<<(basic_json& j, std::istream& i) + { + return operator>>(i, j); + } + + /// @brief deserialize from stream + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/operator_gtgt/ + friend std::istream& operator>>(std::istream& i, basic_json& j) + { + parser(detail::input_adapter(i)).parse(false, j); + return i; + } +#endif // JSON_NO_IO + /// @} + + /////////////////////////// + // convenience functions // + /////////////////////////// + + /// @brief return the type as string + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/type_name/ + JSON_HEDLEY_RETURNS_NON_NULL + const char* type_name() const noexcept + { + switch (m_type) + { + case value_t::null: + return "null"; + case value_t::object: + return "object"; + case value_t::array: + return "array"; + case value_t::string: + return "string"; + case value_t::boolean: + return "boolean"; + case value_t::binary: + return "binary"; + case value_t::discarded: + return "discarded"; + case value_t::number_integer: + case value_t::number_unsigned: + case value_t::number_float: + default: + return "number"; + } + } + + + JSON_PRIVATE_UNLESS_TESTED: + ////////////////////// + // member variables // + ////////////////////// + + /// the type of the current element + value_t m_type = value_t::null; + + /// the value of the current element + json_value m_value = {}; + +#if JSON_DIAGNOSTICS + /// a pointer to a parent value (for debugging purposes) + basic_json* m_parent = nullptr; +#endif + + ////////////////////////////////////////// + // binary serialization/deserialization // + ////////////////////////////////////////// + + /// @name binary serialization/deserialization support + /// @{ + + public: + /// @brief create a CBOR serialization of a given JSON value + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/to_cbor/ + static std::vector to_cbor(const basic_json& j) + { + std::vector result; + to_cbor(j, result); + return result; + } + + /// @brief create a CBOR serialization of a given JSON value + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/to_cbor/ + static void to_cbor(const basic_json& j, detail::output_adapter o) + { + binary_writer(o).write_cbor(j); + } + + /// @brief create a CBOR serialization of a given JSON value + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/to_cbor/ + static void to_cbor(const basic_json& j, detail::output_adapter o) + { + binary_writer(o).write_cbor(j); + } + + /// @brief create a MessagePack serialization of a given JSON value + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/to_msgpack/ + static std::vector to_msgpack(const basic_json& j) + { + std::vector result; + to_msgpack(j, result); + return result; + } + + /// @brief create a MessagePack serialization of a given JSON value + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/to_msgpack/ + static void to_msgpack(const basic_json& j, detail::output_adapter o) + { + binary_writer(o).write_msgpack(j); + } + + /// @brief create a MessagePack serialization of a given JSON value + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/to_msgpack/ + static void to_msgpack(const basic_json& j, detail::output_adapter o) + { + binary_writer(o).write_msgpack(j); + } + + /// @brief create a UBJSON serialization of a given JSON value + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/to_ubjson/ + static std::vector to_ubjson(const basic_json& j, + const bool use_size = false, + const bool use_type = false) + { + std::vector result; + to_ubjson(j, result, use_size, use_type); + return result; + } + + /// @brief create a UBJSON serialization of a given JSON value + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/to_ubjson/ + static void to_ubjson(const basic_json& j, detail::output_adapter o, + const bool use_size = false, const bool use_type = false) + { + binary_writer(o).write_ubjson(j, use_size, use_type); + } + + /// @brief create a UBJSON serialization of a given JSON value + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/to_ubjson/ + static void to_ubjson(const basic_json& j, detail::output_adapter o, + const bool use_size = false, const bool use_type = false) + { + binary_writer(o).write_ubjson(j, use_size, use_type); + } + + /// @brief create a BSON serialization of a given JSON value + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/to_bson/ + static std::vector to_bson(const basic_json& j) + { + std::vector result; + to_bson(j, result); + return result; + } + + /// @brief create a BSON serialization of a given JSON value + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/to_bson/ + static void to_bson(const basic_json& j, detail::output_adapter o) + { + binary_writer(o).write_bson(j); + } + + /// @brief create a BSON serialization of a given JSON value + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/to_bson/ + static void to_bson(const basic_json& j, detail::output_adapter o) + { + binary_writer(o).write_bson(j); + } + + /// @brief create a JSON value from an input in CBOR format + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/from_cbor/ + template + JSON_HEDLEY_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT + static basic_json from_cbor(InputType&& i, + const bool strict = true, + const bool allow_exceptions = true, + const cbor_tag_handler_t tag_handler = cbor_tag_handler_t::error) + { + basic_json result; + detail::json_sax_dom_parser sdp(result, allow_exceptions); + auto ia = detail::input_adapter(std::forward(i)); + const bool res = binary_reader(std::move(ia)).sax_parse(input_format_t::cbor, &sdp, strict, tag_handler); + return res ? result : basic_json(value_t::discarded); + } + + /// @brief create a JSON value from an input in CBOR format + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/from_cbor/ + template + JSON_HEDLEY_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT + static basic_json from_cbor(IteratorType first, IteratorType last, + const bool strict = true, + const bool allow_exceptions = true, + const cbor_tag_handler_t tag_handler = cbor_tag_handler_t::error) + { + basic_json result; + detail::json_sax_dom_parser sdp(result, allow_exceptions); + auto ia = detail::input_adapter(std::move(first), std::move(last)); + const bool res = binary_reader(std::move(ia)).sax_parse(input_format_t::cbor, &sdp, strict, tag_handler); + return res ? result : basic_json(value_t::discarded); + } + + template + JSON_HEDLEY_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT + JSON_HEDLEY_DEPRECATED_FOR(3.8.0, from_cbor(ptr, ptr + len)) + static basic_json from_cbor(const T* ptr, std::size_t len, + const bool strict = true, + const bool allow_exceptions = true, + const cbor_tag_handler_t tag_handler = cbor_tag_handler_t::error) + { + return from_cbor(ptr, ptr + len, strict, allow_exceptions, tag_handler); + } + + + JSON_HEDLEY_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT + JSON_HEDLEY_DEPRECATED_FOR(3.8.0, from_cbor(ptr, ptr + len)) + static basic_json from_cbor(detail::span_input_adapter&& i, + const bool strict = true, + const bool allow_exceptions = true, + const cbor_tag_handler_t tag_handler = cbor_tag_handler_t::error) + { + basic_json result; + detail::json_sax_dom_parser sdp(result, allow_exceptions); + auto ia = i.get(); + // NOLINTNEXTLINE(hicpp-move-const-arg,performance-move-const-arg) + const bool res = binary_reader(std::move(ia)).sax_parse(input_format_t::cbor, &sdp, strict, tag_handler); + return res ? result : basic_json(value_t::discarded); + } + + /// @brief create a JSON value from an input in MessagePack format + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/from_msgpack/ + template + JSON_HEDLEY_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT + static basic_json from_msgpack(InputType&& i, + const bool strict = true, + const bool allow_exceptions = true) + { + basic_json result; + detail::json_sax_dom_parser sdp(result, allow_exceptions); + auto ia = detail::input_adapter(std::forward(i)); + const bool res = binary_reader(std::move(ia)).sax_parse(input_format_t::msgpack, &sdp, strict); + return res ? result : basic_json(value_t::discarded); + } + + /// @brief create a JSON value from an input in MessagePack format + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/from_msgpack/ + template + JSON_HEDLEY_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT + static basic_json from_msgpack(IteratorType first, IteratorType last, + const bool strict = true, + const bool allow_exceptions = true) + { + basic_json result; + detail::json_sax_dom_parser sdp(result, allow_exceptions); + auto ia = detail::input_adapter(std::move(first), std::move(last)); + const bool res = binary_reader(std::move(ia)).sax_parse(input_format_t::msgpack, &sdp, strict); + return res ? result : basic_json(value_t::discarded); + } + + template + JSON_HEDLEY_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT + JSON_HEDLEY_DEPRECATED_FOR(3.8.0, from_msgpack(ptr, ptr + len)) + static basic_json from_msgpack(const T* ptr, std::size_t len, + const bool strict = true, + const bool allow_exceptions = true) + { + return from_msgpack(ptr, ptr + len, strict, allow_exceptions); + } + + JSON_HEDLEY_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT + JSON_HEDLEY_DEPRECATED_FOR(3.8.0, from_msgpack(ptr, ptr + len)) + static basic_json from_msgpack(detail::span_input_adapter&& i, + const bool strict = true, + const bool allow_exceptions = true) + { + basic_json result; + detail::json_sax_dom_parser sdp(result, allow_exceptions); + auto ia = i.get(); + // NOLINTNEXTLINE(hicpp-move-const-arg,performance-move-const-arg) + const bool res = binary_reader(std::move(ia)).sax_parse(input_format_t::msgpack, &sdp, strict); + return res ? result : basic_json(value_t::discarded); + } + + /// @brief create a JSON value from an input in UBJSON format + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/from_ubjson/ + template + JSON_HEDLEY_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT + static basic_json from_ubjson(InputType&& i, + const bool strict = true, + const bool allow_exceptions = true) + { + basic_json result; + detail::json_sax_dom_parser sdp(result, allow_exceptions); + auto ia = detail::input_adapter(std::forward(i)); + const bool res = binary_reader(std::move(ia)).sax_parse(input_format_t::ubjson, &sdp, strict); + return res ? result : basic_json(value_t::discarded); + } + + /// @brief create a JSON value from an input in UBJSON format + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/from_ubjson/ + template + JSON_HEDLEY_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT + static basic_json from_ubjson(IteratorType first, IteratorType last, + const bool strict = true, + const bool allow_exceptions = true) + { + basic_json result; + detail::json_sax_dom_parser sdp(result, allow_exceptions); + auto ia = detail::input_adapter(std::move(first), std::move(last)); + const bool res = binary_reader(std::move(ia)).sax_parse(input_format_t::ubjson, &sdp, strict); + return res ? result : basic_json(value_t::discarded); + } + + template + JSON_HEDLEY_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT + JSON_HEDLEY_DEPRECATED_FOR(3.8.0, from_ubjson(ptr, ptr + len)) + static basic_json from_ubjson(const T* ptr, std::size_t len, + const bool strict = true, + const bool allow_exceptions = true) + { + return from_ubjson(ptr, ptr + len, strict, allow_exceptions); + } + + JSON_HEDLEY_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT + JSON_HEDLEY_DEPRECATED_FOR(3.8.0, from_ubjson(ptr, ptr + len)) + static basic_json from_ubjson(detail::span_input_adapter&& i, + const bool strict = true, + const bool allow_exceptions = true) + { + basic_json result; + detail::json_sax_dom_parser sdp(result, allow_exceptions); + auto ia = i.get(); + // NOLINTNEXTLINE(hicpp-move-const-arg,performance-move-const-arg) + const bool res = binary_reader(std::move(ia)).sax_parse(input_format_t::ubjson, &sdp, strict); + return res ? result : basic_json(value_t::discarded); + } + + /// @brief create a JSON value from an input in BSON format + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/from_bson/ + template + JSON_HEDLEY_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT + static basic_json from_bson(InputType&& i, + const bool strict = true, + const bool allow_exceptions = true) + { + basic_json result; + detail::json_sax_dom_parser sdp(result, allow_exceptions); + auto ia = detail::input_adapter(std::forward(i)); + const bool res = binary_reader(std::move(ia)).sax_parse(input_format_t::bson, &sdp, strict); + return res ? result : basic_json(value_t::discarded); + } + + /// @brief create a JSON value from an input in BSON format + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/from_bson/ + template + JSON_HEDLEY_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT + static basic_json from_bson(IteratorType first, IteratorType last, + const bool strict = true, + const bool allow_exceptions = true) + { + basic_json result; + detail::json_sax_dom_parser sdp(result, allow_exceptions); + auto ia = detail::input_adapter(std::move(first), std::move(last)); + const bool res = binary_reader(std::move(ia)).sax_parse(input_format_t::bson, &sdp, strict); + return res ? result : basic_json(value_t::discarded); + } + + template + JSON_HEDLEY_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT + JSON_HEDLEY_DEPRECATED_FOR(3.8.0, from_bson(ptr, ptr + len)) + static basic_json from_bson(const T* ptr, std::size_t len, + const bool strict = true, + const bool allow_exceptions = true) + { + return from_bson(ptr, ptr + len, strict, allow_exceptions); + } + + JSON_HEDLEY_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT + JSON_HEDLEY_DEPRECATED_FOR(3.8.0, from_bson(ptr, ptr + len)) + static basic_json from_bson(detail::span_input_adapter&& i, + const bool strict = true, + const bool allow_exceptions = true) + { + basic_json result; + detail::json_sax_dom_parser sdp(result, allow_exceptions); + auto ia = i.get(); + // NOLINTNEXTLINE(hicpp-move-const-arg,performance-move-const-arg) + const bool res = binary_reader(std::move(ia)).sax_parse(input_format_t::bson, &sdp, strict); + return res ? result : basic_json(value_t::discarded); + } + /// @} + + ////////////////////////// + // JSON Pointer support // + ////////////////////////// + + /// @name JSON Pointer functions + /// @{ + + /// @brief access specified element via JSON Pointer + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/operator%5B%5D/ + reference operator[](const json_pointer& ptr) + { + return ptr.get_unchecked(this); + } + + /// @brief access specified element via JSON Pointer + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/operator%5B%5D/ + const_reference operator[](const json_pointer& ptr) const + { + return ptr.get_unchecked(this); + } + + /// @brief access specified element via JSON Pointer + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/at/ + reference at(const json_pointer& ptr) + { + return ptr.get_checked(this); + } + + /// @brief access specified element via JSON Pointer + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/at/ + const_reference at(const json_pointer& ptr) const + { + return ptr.get_checked(this); + } + + /// @brief return flattened JSON value + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/flatten/ + basic_json flatten() const + { + basic_json result(value_t::object); + json_pointer::flatten("", *this, result); + return result; + } + + /// @brief unflatten a previously flattened JSON value + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/unflatten/ + basic_json unflatten() const + { + return json_pointer::unflatten(*this); + } + + /// @} + + ////////////////////////// + // JSON Patch functions // + ////////////////////////// + + /// @name JSON Patch functions + /// @{ + + /// @brief applies a JSON patch + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/patch/ + basic_json patch(const basic_json& json_patch) const + { + // make a working copy to apply the patch to + basic_json result = *this; + + // the valid JSON Patch operations + enum class patch_operations {add, remove, replace, move, copy, test, invalid}; + + const auto get_op = [](const std::string & op) + { + if (op == "add") + { + return patch_operations::add; + } + if (op == "remove") + { + return patch_operations::remove; + } + if (op == "replace") + { + return patch_operations::replace; + } + if (op == "move") + { + return patch_operations::move; + } + if (op == "copy") + { + return patch_operations::copy; + } + if (op == "test") + { + return patch_operations::test; + } + + return patch_operations::invalid; + }; + + // wrapper for "add" operation; add value at ptr + const auto operation_add = [&result](json_pointer & ptr, basic_json val) + { + // adding to the root of the target document means replacing it + if (ptr.empty()) + { + result = val; + return; + } + + // make sure the top element of the pointer exists + json_pointer top_pointer = ptr.top(); + if (top_pointer != ptr) + { + result.at(top_pointer); + } + + // get reference to parent of JSON pointer ptr + const auto last_path = ptr.back(); + ptr.pop_back(); + basic_json& parent = result[ptr]; + + switch (parent.m_type) + { + case value_t::null: + case value_t::object: + { + // use operator[] to add value + parent[last_path] = val; + break; + } + + case value_t::array: + { + if (last_path == "-") + { + // special case: append to back + parent.push_back(val); + } + else + { + const auto idx = json_pointer::array_index(last_path); + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(idx > parent.size())) + { + // avoid undefined behavior + JSON_THROW(out_of_range::create(401, "array index " + std::to_string(idx) + " is out of range", parent)); + } + + // default case: insert add offset + parent.insert(parent.begin() + static_cast(idx), val); + } + break; + } + + // if there exists a parent it cannot be primitive + case value_t::string: // LCOV_EXCL_LINE + case value_t::boolean: // LCOV_EXCL_LINE + case value_t::number_integer: // LCOV_EXCL_LINE + case value_t::number_unsigned: // LCOV_EXCL_LINE + case value_t::number_float: // LCOV_EXCL_LINE + case value_t::binary: // LCOV_EXCL_LINE + case value_t::discarded: // LCOV_EXCL_LINE + default: // LCOV_EXCL_LINE + JSON_ASSERT(false); // NOLINT(cert-dcl03-c,hicpp-static-assert,misc-static-assert) LCOV_EXCL_LINE + } + }; + + // wrapper for "remove" operation; remove value at ptr + const auto operation_remove = [this, &result](json_pointer & ptr) + { + // get reference to parent of JSON pointer ptr + const auto last_path = ptr.back(); + ptr.pop_back(); + basic_json& parent = result.at(ptr); + + // remove child + if (parent.is_object()) + { + // perform range check + auto it = parent.find(last_path); + if (JSON_HEDLEY_LIKELY(it != parent.end())) + { + parent.erase(it); + } + else + { + JSON_THROW(out_of_range::create(403, "key '" + last_path + "' not found", *this)); + } + } + else if (parent.is_array()) + { + // note erase performs range check + parent.erase(json_pointer::array_index(last_path)); + } + }; + + // type check: top level value must be an array + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!json_patch.is_array())) + { + JSON_THROW(parse_error::create(104, 0, "JSON patch must be an array of objects", json_patch)); + } + + // iterate and apply the operations + for (const auto& val : json_patch) + { + // wrapper to get a value for an operation + const auto get_value = [&val](const std::string & op, + const std::string & member, + bool string_type) -> basic_json & + { + // find value + auto it = val.m_value.object->find(member); + + // context-sensitive error message + const auto error_msg = (op == "op") ? "operation" : "operation '" + op + "'"; + + // check if desired value is present + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(it == val.m_value.object->end())) + { + // NOLINTNEXTLINE(performance-inefficient-string-concatenation) + JSON_THROW(parse_error::create(105, 0, error_msg + " must have member '" + member + "'", val)); + } + + // check if result is of type string + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(string_type && !it->second.is_string())) + { + // NOLINTNEXTLINE(performance-inefficient-string-concatenation) + JSON_THROW(parse_error::create(105, 0, error_msg + " must have string member '" + member + "'", val)); + } + + // no error: return value + return it->second; + }; + + // type check: every element of the array must be an object + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!val.is_object())) + { + JSON_THROW(parse_error::create(104, 0, "JSON patch must be an array of objects", val)); + } + + // collect mandatory members + const auto op = get_value("op", "op", true).template get(); + const auto path = get_value(op, "path", true).template get(); + json_pointer ptr(path); + + switch (get_op(op)) + { + case patch_operations::add: + { + operation_add(ptr, get_value("add", "value", false)); + break; + } + + case patch_operations::remove: + { + operation_remove(ptr); + break; + } + + case patch_operations::replace: + { + // the "path" location must exist - use at() + result.at(ptr) = get_value("replace", "value", false); + break; + } + + case patch_operations::move: + { + const auto from_path = get_value("move", "from", true).template get(); + json_pointer from_ptr(from_path); + + // the "from" location must exist - use at() + basic_json v = result.at(from_ptr); + + // The move operation is functionally identical to a + // "remove" operation on the "from" location, followed + // immediately by an "add" operation at the target + // location with the value that was just removed. + operation_remove(from_ptr); + operation_add(ptr, v); + break; + } + + case patch_operations::copy: + { + const auto from_path = get_value("copy", "from", true).template get(); + const json_pointer from_ptr(from_path); + + // the "from" location must exist - use at() + basic_json v = result.at(from_ptr); + + // The copy is functionally identical to an "add" + // operation at the target location using the value + // specified in the "from" member. + operation_add(ptr, v); + break; + } + + case patch_operations::test: + { + bool success = false; + JSON_TRY + { + // check if "value" matches the one at "path" + // the "path" location must exist - use at() + success = (result.at(ptr) == get_value("test", "value", false)); + } + JSON_INTERNAL_CATCH (out_of_range&) + { + // ignore out of range errors: success remains false + } + + // throw an exception if test fails + if (JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY(!success)) + { + JSON_THROW(other_error::create(501, "unsuccessful: " + val.dump(), val)); + } + + break; + } + + case patch_operations::invalid: + default: + { + // op must be "add", "remove", "replace", "move", "copy", or + // "test" + JSON_THROW(parse_error::create(105, 0, "operation value '" + op + "' is invalid", val)); + } + } + } + + return result; + } + + /// @brief creates a diff as a JSON patch + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/diff/ + JSON_HEDLEY_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT + static basic_json diff(const basic_json& source, const basic_json& target, + const std::string& path = "") + { + // the patch + basic_json result(value_t::array); + + // if the values are the same, return empty patch + if (source == target) + { + return result; + } + + if (source.type() != target.type()) + { + // different types: replace value + result.push_back( + { + {"op", "replace"}, {"path", path}, {"value", target} + }); + return result; + } + + switch (source.type()) + { + case value_t::array: + { + // first pass: traverse common elements + std::size_t i = 0; + while (i < source.size() && i < target.size()) + { + // recursive call to compare array values at index i + auto temp_diff = diff(source[i], target[i], path + "/" + std::to_string(i)); + result.insert(result.end(), temp_diff.begin(), temp_diff.end()); + ++i; + } + + // We now reached the end of at least one array + // in a second pass, traverse the remaining elements + + // remove my remaining elements + const auto end_index = static_cast(result.size()); + while (i < source.size()) + { + // add operations in reverse order to avoid invalid + // indices + result.insert(result.begin() + end_index, object( + { + {"op", "remove"}, + {"path", path + "/" + std::to_string(i)} + })); + ++i; + } + + // add other remaining elements + while (i < target.size()) + { + result.push_back( + { + {"op", "add"}, + {"path", path + "/-"}, + {"value", target[i]} + }); + ++i; + } + + break; + } + + case value_t::object: + { + // first pass: traverse this object's elements + for (auto it = source.cbegin(); it != source.cend(); ++it) + { + // escape the key name to be used in a JSON patch + const auto path_key = path + "/" + detail::escape(it.key()); + + if (target.find(it.key()) != target.end()) + { + // recursive call to compare object values at key it + auto temp_diff = diff(it.value(), target[it.key()], path_key); + result.insert(result.end(), temp_diff.begin(), temp_diff.end()); + } + else + { + // found a key that is not in o -> remove it + result.push_back(object( + { + {"op", "remove"}, {"path", path_key} + })); + } + } + + // second pass: traverse other object's elements + for (auto it = target.cbegin(); it != target.cend(); ++it) + { + if (source.find(it.key()) == source.end()) + { + // found a key that is not in this -> add it + const auto path_key = path + "/" + detail::escape(it.key()); + result.push_back( + { + {"op", "add"}, {"path", path_key}, + {"value", it.value()} + }); + } + } + + break; + } + + case value_t::null: + case value_t::string: + case value_t::boolean: + case value_t::number_integer: + case value_t::number_unsigned: + case value_t::number_float: + case value_t::binary: + case value_t::discarded: + default: + { + // both primitive type: replace value + result.push_back( + { + {"op", "replace"}, {"path", path}, {"value", target} + }); + break; + } + } + + return result; + } + + /// @} + + //////////////////////////////// + // JSON Merge Patch functions // + //////////////////////////////// + + /// @name JSON Merge Patch functions + /// @{ + + /// @brief applies a JSON Merge Patch + /// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/merge_patch/ + void merge_patch(const basic_json& apply_patch) + { + if (apply_patch.is_object()) + { + if (!is_object()) + { + *this = object(); + } + for (auto it = apply_patch.begin(); it != apply_patch.end(); ++it) + { + if (it.value().is_null()) + { + erase(it.key()); + } + else + { + operator[](it.key()).merge_patch(it.value()); + } + } + } + else + { + *this = apply_patch; + } + } + + /// @} +}; + +/// @brief user-defined to_string function for JSON values +/// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/to_string/ +NLOHMANN_BASIC_JSON_TPL_DECLARATION +std::string to_string(const NLOHMANN_BASIC_JSON_TPL& j) +{ + return j.dump(); +} + +} // namespace nlohmann + +/////////////////////// +// nonmember support // +/////////////////////// + +namespace std // NOLINT(cert-dcl58-cpp) +{ + +/// @brief hash value for JSON objects +/// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/std_hash/ +NLOHMANN_BASIC_JSON_TPL_DECLARATION +struct hash +{ + std::size_t operator()(const nlohmann::NLOHMANN_BASIC_JSON_TPL& j) const + { + return nlohmann::detail::hash(j); + } +}; + +// specialization for std::less +template<> +struct less< ::nlohmann::detail::value_t> // do not remove the space after '<', see https://github.com/nlohmann/json/pull/679 +{ + /*! + @brief compare two value_t enum values + @since version 3.0.0 + */ + bool operator()(nlohmann::detail::value_t lhs, + nlohmann::detail::value_t rhs) const noexcept + { + return nlohmann::detail::operator<(lhs, rhs); + } +}; + +// C++20 prohibit function specialization in the std namespace. +#ifndef JSON_HAS_CPP_20 + +/// @brief exchanges the values of two JSON objects +/// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/std_swap/ +NLOHMANN_BASIC_JSON_TPL_DECLARATION +inline void swap(nlohmann::NLOHMANN_BASIC_JSON_TPL& j1, nlohmann::NLOHMANN_BASIC_JSON_TPL& j2) noexcept( // NOLINT(readability-inconsistent-declaration-parameter-name) + is_nothrow_move_constructible::value&& // NOLINT(misc-redundant-expression) + is_nothrow_move_assignable::value) +{ + j1.swap(j2); +} + +#endif + +} // namespace std + +/// @brief user-defined string literal for JSON values +/// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/operator_literal_json/ +JSON_HEDLEY_NON_NULL(1) +inline nlohmann::json operator "" _json(const char* s, std::size_t n) +{ + return nlohmann::json::parse(s, s + n); +} + +/// @brief user-defined string literal for JSON pointer +/// @sa https://json.nlohmann.me/api/basic_json/operator_literal_json_pointer/ +JSON_HEDLEY_NON_NULL(1) +inline nlohmann::json::json_pointer operator "" _json_pointer(const char* s, std::size_t n) +{ + return nlohmann::json::json_pointer(std::string(s, n)); +} + +// #include + + +// restore clang diagnostic settings +#if defined(__clang__) + #pragma clang diagnostic pop +#endif + +// clean up +#undef JSON_ASSERT +#undef JSON_INTERNAL_CATCH +#undef JSON_CATCH +#undef JSON_THROW +#undef JSON_TRY +#undef JSON_PRIVATE_UNLESS_TESTED +#undef JSON_HAS_CPP_11 +#undef JSON_HAS_CPP_14 +#undef JSON_HAS_CPP_17 +#undef JSON_HAS_CPP_20 +#undef JSON_HAS_FILESYSTEM +#undef JSON_HAS_EXPERIMENTAL_FILESYSTEM +#undef NLOHMANN_BASIC_JSON_TPL_DECLARATION +#undef NLOHMANN_BASIC_JSON_TPL +#undef JSON_EXPLICIT +#undef NLOHMANN_CAN_CALL_STD_FUNC_IMPL + +// #include + + +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_ALWAYS_INLINE +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_ARM_VERSION +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_ARM_VERSION_CHECK +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_ARRAY_PARAM +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_ASSUME +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_BEGIN_C_DECLS +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_CLANG_HAS_ATTRIBUTE +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_CLANG_HAS_BUILTIN +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_CLANG_HAS_CPP_ATTRIBUTE +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_CLANG_HAS_DECLSPEC_DECLSPEC_ATTRIBUTE +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_CLANG_HAS_EXTENSION +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_CLANG_HAS_FEATURE +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_CLANG_HAS_WARNING +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_COMPCERT_VERSION +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_COMPCERT_VERSION_CHECK +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_CONCAT +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_CONCAT3 +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_CONCAT3_EX +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_CONCAT_EX +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_CONST +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_CONSTEXPR +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_CONST_CAST +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_CPP_CAST +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_CRAY_VERSION +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_CRAY_VERSION_CHECK +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_C_DECL +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_DEPRECATED +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_DEPRECATED_FOR +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_CAST_QUAL +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_CPP98_COMPAT_WRAP_ +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_DEPRECATED +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_UNKNOWN_CPP_ATTRIBUTES +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_UNKNOWN_PRAGMAS +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_DISABLE_UNUSED_FUNCTION +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_POP +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_DIAGNOSTIC_PUSH +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_DMC_VERSION +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_DMC_VERSION_CHECK +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_EMPTY_BASES +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_EMSCRIPTEN_VERSION +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_EMSCRIPTEN_VERSION_CHECK +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_END_C_DECLS +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_FLAGS +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_FLAGS_CAST +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_HAS_ATTRIBUTE +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_HAS_BUILTIN +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_HAS_CPP_ATTRIBUTE +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_HAS_DECLSPEC_ATTRIBUTE +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_HAS_EXTENSION +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_HAS_FEATURE +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_HAS_WARNING +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_NOT_CLANG_VERSION_CHECK +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_VERSION +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_GCC_VERSION_CHECK +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_GNUC_HAS_ATTRIBUTE +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_GNUC_HAS_BUILTIN +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_GNUC_HAS_CPP_ATTRIBUTE +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_GNUC_HAS_DECLSPEC_ATTRIBUTE +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_GNUC_HAS_EXTENSION +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_GNUC_HAS_FEATURE +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_GNUC_HAS_WARNING +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_GNUC_VERSION +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_GNUC_VERSION_CHECK +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_ATTRIBUTE +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_BUILTIN +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_CPP_ATTRIBUTE +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_CPP_ATTRIBUTE_NS +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_DECLSPEC_ATTRIBUTE +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_EXTENSION +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_FEATURE +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_HAS_WARNING +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_IAR_VERSION +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_IAR_VERSION_CHECK +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_IBM_VERSION +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_IBM_VERSION_CHECK +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_IMPORT +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_INLINE +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_CL_VERSION +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_CL_VERSION_CHECK +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_VERSION +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_INTEL_VERSION_CHECK +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_IS_CONSTANT +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_IS_CONSTEXPR_ +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_LIKELY +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_MALLOC +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_MCST_LCC_VERSION +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_MCST_LCC_VERSION_CHECK +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_MESSAGE +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_MSVC_VERSION +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_MSVC_VERSION_CHECK +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_NEVER_INLINE +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_NON_NULL +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_NO_ESCAPE +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_NO_RETURN +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_NO_THROW +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_NULL +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_PELLES_VERSION +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_PELLES_VERSION_CHECK +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_PGI_VERSION +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_PGI_VERSION_CHECK +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_PREDICT +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_PRINTF_FORMAT +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_PRIVATE +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_PUBLIC +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_PURE +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_REINTERPRET_CAST +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_REQUIRE +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_REQUIRE_CONSTEXPR +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_REQUIRE_MSG +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_RESTRICT +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_RETURNS_NON_NULL +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_SENTINEL +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_STATIC_ASSERT +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_STATIC_CAST +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_STRINGIFY +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_STRINGIFY_EX +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_SUNPRO_VERSION +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_SUNPRO_VERSION_CHECK +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_TINYC_VERSION +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_TINYC_VERSION_CHECK +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_TI_ARMCL_VERSION +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_TI_ARMCL_VERSION_CHECK +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL2000_VERSION +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL2000_VERSION_CHECK +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL430_VERSION +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL430_VERSION_CHECK +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL6X_VERSION +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL6X_VERSION_CHECK +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL7X_VERSION +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CL7X_VERSION_CHECK +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CLPRU_VERSION +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_TI_CLPRU_VERSION_CHECK +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_TI_VERSION +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_TI_VERSION_CHECK +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_UNAVAILABLE +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_UNLIKELY +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_UNPREDICTABLE +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_UNREACHABLE +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_UNREACHABLE_RETURN +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_DECODE_MAJOR +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_DECODE_MINOR +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_DECODE_REVISION +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_VERSION_ENCODE +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_WARNING +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT_MSG +#undef JSON_HEDLEY_FALL_THROUGH + + + +#endif // INCLUDE_NLOHMANN_JSON_HPP_ diff --git a/CMakeLists.txt b/CMakeLists.txt index dedcd1e..ef46013 100644 --- a/CMakeLists.txt +++ b/CMakeLists.txt @@ -23,20 +23,22 @@ set(ozz_build_gltf ON) set(ozz_build_data OFF CACHE BOOL "") set(ozz_build_samples OFF CACHE BOOL "") set(ozz_build_howtos OFF CACHE BOOL "") -set(ozz_build_tests OFF CACHE BOOL "") +set(ozz_build_tests ON CACHE BOOL "") set(ozz_build_simd_ref OFF CACHE BOOL "") set(ozz_build_msvc_rt_dll OFF CACHE BOOL "") add_subdirectory(3rdparty/ozz-animation) -set (ThirdPartyIncludeDeps +set(ThirdPartyIncludeDeps PUBLIC $ PUBLIC $ PUBLIC $ PUBLIC $ PUBLIC $ + PUBLIC $ PUBLIC $ PUBLIC $ PUBLIC $ + PUBLIC $ ) # Shared code by main executable and tests @@ -57,7 +59,9 @@ add_library(AnimTestbedCode OBJECT 3rdparty/imgui/imgui.cpp 3rdparty/imgui/imgui_draw.cpp 3rdparty/imgui/imgui_widgets.cpp - ) + 3rdparty/imnodes/imnodes.cpp + src/AnimGraphResource.cc + src/AnimGraphResource.h src/AnimGraphEditor.cc src/AnimGraphEditor.h) target_include_directories( AnimTestbedCode @@ -66,6 +70,8 @@ target_include_directories( ${ThirdPartyIncludeDeps} ) +target_compile_features(AnimTestbedCode PRIVATE cxx_std_17) + # AnimTestbed Executable add_executable(AnimTestbed) target_include_directories( @@ -88,11 +94,19 @@ target_link_libraries(AnimTestbed AnimTestbedCode glfw ozz_base ozz_geometry ozz # Tests add_executable(runtests) -target_sources(runtests PRIVATE tests/main.cc tests/AnimSampleNodeTests.cc tests/SyncTrackTests.cc) +target_sources(runtests PRIVATE + tests/AnimGraphResourceTests.cc + tests/AnimSampleNodeTests.cc + tests/SyncTrackTests.cc + tests/main.cc + ) + target_include_directories( runtests PUBLIC $ ${ThirdPartyIncludeDeps} ) +target_compile_features(runtests PRIVATE cxx_std_17) + target_link_libraries(runtests AnimTestbedCode glfw ozz_base ozz_geometry ozz_animation) diff --git a/src/AnimGraphEditor.cc b/src/AnimGraphEditor.cc new file mode 100644 index 0000000..1ccd244 --- /dev/null +++ b/src/AnimGraphEditor.cc @@ -0,0 +1,118 @@ +// +// Created by martin on 11.02.22. +// + +#include "AnimGraphEditor.h" + +#include "imnodes.h" + +#include "AnimGraphResource.h" + +static AnimGraphResource gGraphResource; + +constexpr int NodeInputAttributeFlag = 2 << 16; +constexpr int NodeOutputAttributeFlag = 2 << 17; + + +void AnimGraphEditorUpdate() { + ImGui::BeginMenuBar(); + if (ImGui::Button("Save")) { + gGraphResource.saveToFile("editor_graph.json"); + } + if (ImGui::Button("Load")) { + gGraphResource.loadFromFile("editor_graph.json"); + + for (size_t i = 0, n = gGraphResource.m_nodes.size(); i < n; i++) { + const AnimNodeResource& node_resource = gGraphResource.m_nodes[i]; + ImNodes::SetNodeGridSpacePos(i, ImVec2(node_resource.m_position[0], node_resource.m_position[1])); + } + } + if (ImGui::Button("Clear")) { + gGraphResource.clear(); + } + char graph_name_buffer[256]; + memset (graph_name_buffer, 0, sizeof(graph_name_buffer)); + strncpy (graph_name_buffer, gGraphResource.m_name.c_str(), sizeof(graph_name_buffer)); + if (ImGui::InputText("Name", graph_name_buffer, sizeof(graph_name_buffer))) { + gGraphResource.m_name = graph_name_buffer; + } + + ImGui::EndMenuBar(); + + ImNodes::BeginNodeEditor(); + + if (ImGui::IsWindowFocused(ImGuiFocusedFlags_RootAndChildWindows) && ImNodes::IsEditorHovered() + && ImGui::IsMouseReleased(ImGuiMouseButton_Right)) { + AnimNodeResource node_resource = AnimNodeResourceFactory("Blend2"); + size_t node_id = gGraphResource.m_nodes.size(); + ImNodes::SetNodeScreenSpacePos(node_id, ImGui::GetMousePos()); + gGraphResource.m_nodes.push_back(node_resource); + } + + for (size_t i = 0, n = gGraphResource.m_nodes.size(); i < n; i++) { + AnimNodeResource& node_resource = gGraphResource.m_nodes[i]; + + ImNodes::BeginNode(i); + + // Header + ImNodes::BeginNodeTitleBar(); + ImGui::TextUnformatted(node_resource.m_type_name.c_str()); + ImNodes::EndNodeTitleBar(); + + // Inputs + const std::vector& node_inputs =node_resource.m_socket_accessor->m_inputs; + for (size_t j = 0, ni = node_inputs.size(); j < ni; j++) { + const Socket& socket = node_inputs[j]; + ImNodes::BeginInputAttribute(GenerateInputAttributeId(i, j)); + ImGui::Text(socket.m_name.c_str()); + ImNodes::EndInputAttribute(); + } + + // Outputs + const std::vector& node_outputs =node_resource.m_socket_accessor->m_outputs; + for (size_t j = 0, ni = node_outputs.size(); j < ni; j++) { + const Socket& socket = node_outputs[j]; + ImNodes::BeginOutputAttribute(GenerateOutputAttributeId(i, j)); + ImGui::Text(socket.m_name.c_str()); + ImNodes::EndInputAttribute(); + } + + // Save state in node resource + ImVec2 node_pos = ImNodes::GetNodeGridSpacePos(i); + node_resource.m_position[0] = node_pos[0]; + node_resource.m_position[1] = node_pos[1]; + ImNodes::EndNode(); + } + + for (size_t i = 0, n = gGraphResource.m_connections.size(); i < n; i++) { + const AnimGraphConnection& connection = gGraphResource.m_connections[i]; + int start_attr, end_attr; + start_attr = GenerateOutputAttributeId(connection.m_source_node_index, connection.m_source_socket_index); + end_attr = GenerateInputAttributeId(connection.m_target_node_index, connection.m_target_socket_index); + ImNodes::Link(i, start_attr, end_attr); + } + + ImNodes::EndNodeEditor(); + + int start_attr, end_attr; + if (ImNodes::IsLinkCreated(&start_attr, &end_attr)) { + int node_start_id; + int node_start_output_index; + SplitOutputAttributeId(start_attr, &node_start_id, &node_start_output_index); + + int node_end_id; + int node_end_input_index; + SplitInputAttributeId(end_attr, &node_end_id, &node_end_input_index); + + std::cout << "Link created: " << node_start_id << ", " << node_start_output_index << " -> " + << node_end_id << ", " << node_end_input_index << std::endl; + + AnimGraphConnection connection; + connection.m_source_node_index = node_start_id; + connection.m_source_socket_index = node_start_output_index; + + connection.m_target_node_index = node_end_id; + connection.m_target_socket_index = node_end_input_index; + gGraphResource.m_connections.push_back(connection); + } +} \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/src/AnimGraphEditor.h b/src/AnimGraphEditor.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000..a1cf41b --- /dev/null +++ b/src/AnimGraphEditor.h @@ -0,0 +1,10 @@ +// +// Created by martin on 11.02.22. +// + +#ifndef ANIMTESTBED_ANIMGRAPHEDITOR_H +#define ANIMTESTBED_ANIMGRAPHEDITOR_H + +void AnimGraphEditorUpdate(); + +#endif //ANIMTESTBED_ANIMGRAPHEDITOR_H diff --git a/src/AnimGraphResource.cc b/src/AnimGraphResource.cc new file mode 100644 index 0000000..c1f2c5b --- /dev/null +++ b/src/AnimGraphResource.cc @@ -0,0 +1,161 @@ +// +// Created by martin on 04.02.22. +// + +#include +#include "AnimGraphResource.h" + +#include "3rdparty/json/json.hpp" + +using json = nlohmann::json; + +std::string sPinTypeToStr (SocketType pin_type) { + std::string result = "unknown"; + switch (pin_type) { + case SocketType::SocketTypeFloat: result = "Float"; break; + case SocketType::SocketTypeAnimation: result = "AnimationData"; break; + default: result = "Unknown"; + } + + return result; +} + +json sSocketToJson(const Socket& pin) { + json result; + result["name"] = pin.m_name; + result["type"] = sPinTypeToStr(pin.m_type); + return result; +} + +json sAnimGraphNodeToJson(const AnimNodeResource& node) { + json result; + + result["name"] = node.m_name; + result["type"] = "AnimNodeResource"; + result["node_type"] = node.m_type_name; + + for (size_t j = 0; j < 2; j++) { + result["position"][j] = node.m_position[j]; + } + + return result; +} + + +AnimNodeResource sAnimGraphNodeFromJson(const json& json_node) { + AnimNodeResource result; + + result.m_name = json_node["name"]; + result.m_type_name = json_node["node_type"]; + result.m_position[0] = json_node["position"][0]; + result.m_position[1] = json_node["position"][1]; + + result.m_anim_node = AnimNodeFactory(result.m_type_name); + result.m_socket_accessor = AnimNodeAccessorFactory(result.m_type_name, result.m_anim_node); + + return result; +} + + +json sAnimGraphConnectionToJson(const AnimGraphConnection& connection) { + json result; + + result["type"] = "AnimGraphConnection"; + + result["source_node_index"] = connection.m_source_node_index; + result["source_socket_index"] = connection.m_source_socket_index; + + result["target_node_index"] = connection.m_target_node_index; + result["target_socket_index"] = connection.m_target_socket_index; + + return result; +} + + +AnimGraphConnection sAnimGraphConnectionFromJson(const json& json_node) { + AnimGraphConnection connection; + + connection.m_source_node_index = json_node["source_node_index"]; + connection.m_source_socket_index = json_node["source_socket_index"]; + + connection.m_target_node_index = json_node["target_node_index"]; + connection.m_target_socket_index = json_node["target_socket_index"]; + + return connection; +} + + +void AnimGraphResource::clear() { + m_name = ""; + m_nodes.clear(); + m_connections.clear(); +} + + +bool AnimGraphResource::saveToFile (const char* filename) const { + json result; + + result["name"] = m_name; + result["type"] = "AnimGraphResource"; + + for (size_t i = 0; i < m_nodes.size(); i++) { + const AnimNodeResource& node = m_nodes[i]; + result["nodes"][i] = sAnimGraphNodeToJson(node); + } + + for (size_t i = 0; i < m_connections.size(); i++) { + const AnimGraphConnection& connection = m_connections[i]; + result["connections"][i] = sAnimGraphConnectionToJson(connection); + } + + std::ofstream output_file; + output_file.open (filename); + output_file << to_string(result) << std::endl; + output_file.close(); + + return true; +} + +bool AnimGraphResource::loadFromFile (const char* filename) { + std::ifstream input_file; + input_file.open(filename); + std::stringstream buffer; + buffer << input_file.rdbuf(); + + json json_data = json::parse(buffer.str(), nullptr, false); + if (json_data.is_discarded()) { + std::cerr << "Error parsing json of file '" << filename << "'." << std::endl; + } + + if (json_data["type"] != "AnimGraphResource") { + std::cerr << "Invalid json object. Expected type 'AnimGraphResource' but got '" << json_data["type"] << "'." << std::endl; + } + + clear(); + + m_name = json_data["name"]; + for (size_t i = 0; i < json_data["nodes"].size(); i++) { + const json& json_node = json_data["nodes"][i]; + if (json_node["type"] != "AnimNodeResource") { + std::cerr << "Invalid json object. Expected type 'AnimNodeResource' but got '" << json_node["type"] << "'." << std::endl; + return false; + } + + AnimNodeResource node = sAnimGraphNodeFromJson(json_node); + m_nodes.push_back(node); + } + + for (size_t i = 0; i < json_data["connections"].size(); i++) { + const json& json_connection = json_data["connections"][i]; + if (json_connection["type"] != "AnimGraphConnection") { + std::cerr << "Invalid json object. Expected type 'AnimGraphConnection' but got '" << json_connection["type"] << "'." << std::endl; + return false; + } + + AnimGraphConnection connection = sAnimGraphConnectionFromJson(json_connection); + m_connections.push_back(connection); + } + + return false; +} + diff --git a/src/AnimGraphResource.h b/src/AnimGraphResource.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000..285ce8c --- /dev/null +++ b/src/AnimGraphResource.h @@ -0,0 +1,556 @@ +// +// Created by martin on 04.02.22. +// + +#ifndef ANIMTESTBED_ANIMGRAPHRESOURCE_H +#define ANIMTESTBED_ANIMGRAPHRESOURCE_H + +#include +#include +#include +#include +#include + +#include "SyncTrack.h" + +enum class SocketType { + SocketTypeUndefined, + SocketTypeBool, + SocketTypeAnimation, + SocketTypeFloat, + SocketTypeVec3, + SocketTypeQuat, + SocketTypeString +}; + +struct AnimData { + float m_bone_transforms[16]; +}; + +typedef float Vec3[3]; +typedef float Quat[4]; + +inline int GenerateInputAttributeId(int node_id, int input_index) { + return ((input_index + 1) << 14) + node_id; +} + +inline void +SplitInputAttributeId(int attribute_id, int* node_id, int* input_index) { + *node_id = attribute_id & ((1 << 14) - 1); + *input_index = (attribute_id >> 14) - 1; +} + +inline int GenerateOutputAttributeId(int node_id, int output_index) { + return ((output_index + 1) << 23) + node_id; +} + +inline void +SplitOutputAttributeId(int attribute_id, int* node_id, int* output_index) { + *node_id = attribute_id & ((1 << 14) - 1); + *output_index = (attribute_id >> 23) - 1; +} + +struct AnimNodeResource; + +struct Socket { + std::string m_name; + SocketType m_type; + union Value { + bool* flag; + AnimData* anim_data; + float* real; + Vec3* vec3; + Quat* quat; + std::string* str; + bool** flag_ptr; + AnimData** anim_data_ptr; + float** real_ptr; + float** vec3_ptr; + float** quat_ptr; + std::string** str_ptr; + }; + Value m_value; +}; + +struct AnimNode; +struct NodeSocketAccessorBase; + +struct AnimNodeResource { + std::string m_name; + std::string m_type_name; + AnimNode* m_anim_node = nullptr; + NodeSocketAccessorBase* m_socket_accessor = nullptr; + + float m_position[2] = {0.f, 0.f}; +}; + +struct AnimNode { + virtual ~AnimNode(){}; + + std::string m_name; + std::string m_node_type_name; + bool m_is_time_synced; + float m_time_now; + float m_time_last; + SyncTrack m_sync_track; +}; + +struct NodeSocketAccessorBase { + NodeSocketAccessorBase(AnimNode* node) {} + virtual ~NodeSocketAccessorBase() {} + + Socket* FindSocket(std::vector& sockets, const std::string& name) { + Socket* result = nullptr; + for (size_t i = 0, n = sockets.size(); i < n; i++) { + if (sockets[i].m_name == name) { + result = &sockets[i]; + break; + } + } + + return result; + } + + SocketType GetSocketType( + const std::vector sockets, + const std::string& name) { + Socket* socket = FindSocket(m_properties, name); + if (socket == nullptr) { + return SocketType::SocketTypeUndefined; + } + return socket->m_type; + } + + template + bool RegisterSocket( + std::vector& sockets, + const std::string& name, + T* value_ptr) { + Socket* socket = FindSocket(sockets, name); + if (socket != nullptr) { + std::cerr << "Socket " << name << " already registered." << std::endl; + return false; + } + + sockets.push_back(Socket()); + socket = &sockets[sockets.size() - 1]; + socket->m_name = name; + + if constexpr (std::is_same::value) { + socket->m_value.real = value_ptr; + socket->m_type = SocketType::SocketTypeFloat; + } else if constexpr (std::is_same::value) { + socket->m_value.flag = value_ptr; + socket->m_type = SocketType::SocketTypeBool; + } else if constexpr (std::is_same::value) { + socket->m_value.vec3 = value_ptr; + socket->m_type = SocketType::SocketTypeVec3; + } else if constexpr (std::is_same::value) { + socket->m_value.quat = value_ptr; + socket->m_type = SocketType::SocketTypeQuat; + } else if constexpr (std::is_same::value) { + socket->m_value.anim_data = value_ptr; + socket->m_type = SocketType::SocketTypeAnimation; + } else if constexpr (std::is_same::value) { + socket->m_value.str = value_ptr; + socket->m_type = SocketType::SocketTypeString; + } else if constexpr (std::is_same::value) { + socket->m_value.real_ptr = value_ptr; + socket->m_type = SocketType::SocketTypeFloat; + } else if constexpr (std::is_same::value) { + socket->m_value.flag_ptr = value_ptr; + socket->m_type = SocketType::SocketTypeBool; + } else if constexpr (std::is_same::value) { + socket->m_value.vec3_ptr = value_ptr; + socket->m_type = SocketType::SocketTypeVec3; + } else if constexpr (std::is_same::value) { + socket->m_value.quat_ptr = value_ptr; + socket->m_type = SocketType::SocketTypeQuat; + } else if constexpr (std::is_same::value) { + socket->m_value.anim_data_ptr = value_ptr; + socket->m_type = SocketType::SocketTypeAnimation; + } else if constexpr (std::is_same::value) { + socket->m_value.str_ptr = value_ptr; + socket->m_type = SocketType::SocketTypeString; + } else { + std::cerr << "Cannot register socket, invalid type." << std::endl; + return false; + } + + return true; + } + + template + bool SetSocketValue( + std::vector& sockets, + const std::string& name, + T value) { + Socket* socket = FindSocket(sockets, name); + if (socket == nullptr) { + return false; + } + + if constexpr (std::is_same::value) { + (*socket->m_value.real) = value; + } else if constexpr (std::is_same::value) { + (*socket->m_value.flag) = value; + } else if constexpr (std::is_same::value) { + (*socket->m_value.vec3) = value; + } else if constexpr (std::is_same::value) { + (*socket->m_value.vec3) = value; + } else if constexpr (std::is_same::value) { + (*socket->m_value.vec3) = value; + } else if constexpr (std::is_same::value) { + (*socket->m_value.str) = value; + } else { + std::cerr << "Invalid type!" << std::endl; + return false; + } + + return true; + } + + template + bool SetSocketRef( + std::vector& sockets, + const std::string& name, + T* value) { + Socket* socket = FindSocket(sockets, name); + if (socket == nullptr) { + return false; + } else if constexpr (std::is_same::value) { + (*socket->m_value.real_ptr) = value; + } else if constexpr (std::is_same::value) { + (*socket->m_value.flag_ptr) = value; + } else if constexpr (std::is_same::value) { + (*socket->m_value.vec3_ptr) = value; + } else if constexpr (std::is_same::value) { + (*socket->m_value.quat_ptr) = value; + } else if constexpr (std::is_same::value) { + (*socket->m_value.anim_data_ptr) = value; + } else if constexpr (std::is_same::value) { + (*socket->m_value.str_ptr) = value; + } else { + std::cerr << "Invalid type!" << std::endl; + return false; + } + + return true; + } + + template + T* GetSocketValue( + std::vector& sockets, + const std::string& name, + T* default_value) { + Socket* socket = FindSocket(sockets, name); + if (socket == nullptr) { + return default_value; + } + + if constexpr (std::is_same::value) { + return socket->m_value.real; + } else if constexpr (std::is_same::value) { + return socket->m_value.vec3; + } else if constexpr (std::is_same::value) { + return socket->m_value.flag; + } else if constexpr (std::is_same::value) { + return socket->m_value.vec3; + } else if constexpr (std::is_same::value) { + return socket->m_value.anim_data; + } else if constexpr (std::is_same::value) { + return socket->m_value.str; + } + + std::cerr << "Invalid type!" << std::endl; + return nullptr; + } + + template + bool RegisterProperty(const std::string& name, T* value) { + return RegisterSocket(m_properties, name, value); + } + template + bool SetProperty(const std::string& name, T value) { + return SetSocketValue(m_properties, name, value); + } + template + T GetProperty(const std::string& name, T value) { + return GetSocketValue(m_properties, name, value); + } + SocketType GetPropertyType(const std::string& name) { + return GetSocketType(m_properties, name); + } + + template + bool RegisterInput(const std::string& name, T* value) { + return RegisterSocket(m_inputs, name, value); + } + template + bool SetInput(const std::string& name, T value) { + return SetSocketValue(m_inputs, name, value); + } + template + T* GetInput(const std::string& name, T* value) { + return GetSocketValue(m_inputs, name, value); + } + SocketType GetInputType(const std::string& name) { + return GetSocketType(m_inputs, name); + } + + template + bool RegisterOutput(const std::string& name, T** value) { + return RegisterSocket(m_outputs, name, value); + } + template + bool SetOutputRef(const std::string& name, T* value) { + return SetSocketRef(m_outputs, name, value); + } + SocketType GetOutputType(const std::string& name) { + return GetSocketType(m_outputs, name); + } + + std::vector m_properties; + std::vector m_inputs; + std::vector m_outputs; +}; + +template +struct NodeSocketAccessor : public NodeSocketAccessorBase { + virtual ~NodeSocketAccessor() {} +}; + +struct NodeRegistry { + AnimNode* createNode(const std::string& node_type); + NodeSocketAccessorBase* createNodeAccessor( + const std::string& node_type, + AnimNode* node); +}; + +struct Blend2Node : public AnimNode { + AnimData m_input0; + AnimData m_input1; + AnimData* m_output = nullptr; + float m_blend_weight = 0.f; + bool m_sync_blend = false; +}; + +template <> +struct NodeSocketAccessor : public NodeSocketAccessorBase { + NodeSocketAccessor(AnimNode* node_) : NodeSocketAccessorBase(node_) { + Blend2Node* node = dynamic_cast(node_); + RegisterInput("Input0", &node->m_input0); + RegisterInput("Input1", &node->m_input1); + RegisterInput("Weight", &node->m_blend_weight); + + RegisterOutput("Output", &node->m_output); + + RegisterProperty("Sync", &node->m_sync_blend); + } +}; + +struct SpeedScaleNode : public AnimNode { + AnimData m_input; + AnimData* m_output = nullptr; + float m_speed_scale = 0.f; +}; + +template <> +struct NodeSocketAccessor : public NodeSocketAccessorBase { + NodeSocketAccessor(AnimNode* node_) : NodeSocketAccessorBase(node_) { + SpeedScaleNode* node = dynamic_cast(node_); + RegisterInput("SpeedScale", &node->m_speed_scale); + RegisterInput("Input", &node->m_input); + + RegisterOutput("Output", &node->m_output); + } +}; + +struct AnimSamplerNode : public AnimNode { + AnimData* m_output = nullptr; + std::string m_filename; +}; + +template <> +struct NodeSocketAccessor : public NodeSocketAccessorBase { + NodeSocketAccessor(AnimNode* node_) : NodeSocketAccessorBase(node_) { + AnimSamplerNode* node = dynamic_cast(node_); + RegisterOutput("Output", &node->m_output); + + RegisterProperty("Filename", &node->m_filename); + } +}; + +struct AnimGraphConnection { + int m_source_node_index; + int m_source_socket_index; + int m_target_node_index; + int m_target_socket_index; +}; + +struct AnimGraphResource { + std::string m_name; + std::vector m_nodes; + std::vector m_connections; + std::vector m_inputs; + std::vector m_outputs; + + void clear(); + bool saveToFile(const char* filename) const; + bool loadFromFile(const char* filename); +}; + +static inline AnimNode* AnimNodeFactory(const std::string& name) { + if (name == "Blend2") { + return new Blend2Node; + } else if (name == "SpeedScale") { + return new SpeedScaleNode; + } else if (name == "AnimSampler") { + return new AnimSamplerNode; + } + + std::cerr << "Invalid node type: " << name << std::endl; + return nullptr; +} + +static inline NodeSocketAccessorBase* AnimNodeAccessorFactory( + const std::string& node_type_name, + AnimNode* node) { + if (node_type_name == "Blend2") { + return new NodeSocketAccessor(node); + } else if (node_type_name == "SpeedScale") { + return new NodeSocketAccessor(node); + } else if (node_type_name == "AnimSampler") { + return new NodeSocketAccessor(node); + } else { + std::cerr << "Invalid node type name " << node_type_name << "." + << std::endl; + } + return nullptr; +} + +static inline AnimNodeResource AnimNodeResourceFactory( + const std::string& node_type_name) { + AnimNodeResource result; + result.m_type_name = node_type_name; + result.m_anim_node = AnimNodeFactory(node_type_name); + result.m_socket_accessor = + AnimNodeAccessorFactory(node_type_name, result.m_anim_node); + return result; +} + +struct AnimGraph { + void UpdateTime(float dt); + void Evaluate(); + + AnimData m_local_transforms; + std::vector m_nodes; + std::vector > m_node_inputs; + + AnimNode* getAnimNode(const char* name) { + for (size_t i = 0; i < m_nodes.size(); i++) { + if (m_nodes[i]->m_name == name) { + return m_nodes[i]; + } + } + + return nullptr; + } + + size_t getAnimNodeIndex(AnimNode* node) { + for (size_t i = 0, n = m_nodes.size(); i < n; i++) { + if (m_nodes[i] == node) { + return i; + } + } + + std::cerr << "Could not find node " << node << "." << std::endl; + return -1; + } + + static AnimGraph createFromResource(const AnimGraphResource& resource) { + AnimGraph result; + for (int i = 0; i < resource.m_nodes.size(); i++) { + const AnimNodeResource& node_resource = resource.m_nodes[i]; + AnimNode* node = AnimNodeFactory(node_resource.m_type_name.c_str()); + node->m_name = node_resource.m_name; + node->m_node_type_name = node_resource.m_type_name; + result.m_nodes.push_back(node); + result.m_node_inputs.push_back(std::vector()); + } + + for (int i = 0; i < resource.m_connections.size(); i++) { + const AnimGraphConnection& connection = resource.m_connections[i]; + std::string source_node_type = ""; + std::string target_node_type = ""; + std::string source_node_name = ""; + std::string target_node_name = ""; + AnimNode* source_node = nullptr; + AnimNode* target_node = nullptr; + NodeSocketAccessorBase* source_node_accessor = nullptr; + NodeSocketAccessorBase* target_node_accessor = nullptr; + SocketType source_type; + SocketType target_type; + + if (connection.m_source_node_index >= 0) { + source_node = result.m_nodes[connection.m_source_node_index]; + source_node_name = source_node->m_name; + source_node_type = source_node->m_node_type_name; + source_node_accessor = + AnimNodeAccessorFactory(source_node_type, source_node); + } + + if (connection.m_target_node_index >= 0) { + target_node = result.m_nodes[connection.m_target_node_index]; + target_node_name = target_node->m_name; + target_node_type = target_node->m_node_type_name; + target_node_accessor = + AnimNodeAccessorFactory(target_node_type, target_node); + } + + assert(source_node != nullptr); + assert(target_node != nullptr); + + if (connection.m_source_socket_index + > source_node_accessor->m_outputs.size()) { + std::cerr << "Invalid source socket index " + << connection.m_source_socket_index << ". Only " + << source_node_accessor->m_outputs.size() + << " output sockets found." << std::endl; + continue; + } + + if (connection.m_target_socket_index + > target_node_accessor->m_inputs.size()) { + std::cerr << "Invalid source socket index " + << connection.m_target_socket_index << ". Only " + << source_node_accessor->m_inputs.size() + << " input sockets found." << std::endl; + continue; + } + + if (source_node_accessor->m_outputs[connection.m_source_socket_index].m_type + != target_node_accessor->m_inputs[connection.m_target_socket_index].m_type) { + std::cerr << "Invalid connection connecting nodes '" << source_node_name + << "' and '" << target_node_name << "'." << std::endl; + return result; + } + + // TODO! How to wire up the different types? +// std::string socket_name = connection.m_target_socket_name; +// AnimData* input_ref = +// target_node_accessor->GetInput(socket_name, nullptr); +// source_node_accessor->SetOutputRef( +// connection.m_source_socket_name, +// input_ref); + + size_t target_node_index = result.getAnimNodeIndex(target_node); + + result.m_node_inputs[target_node_index].push_back(source_node); + } + + return result; + } +}; + +#endif //ANIMTESTBED_ANIMGRAPHRESOURCE_H diff --git a/src/main.cc b/src/main.cc index db00ece..4cbf358 100644 --- a/src/main.cc +++ b/src/main.cc @@ -5,6 +5,7 @@ //------------------------------------------------------------------------------ #include "imgui.h" +#include "imnodes.h" #define SOKOL_IMPL #define SOKOL_GLCORE33 #include "sokol_gfx.h" @@ -16,6 +17,7 @@ #include "Camera.h" #include "SkinnedMesh.h" +#include "AnimGraphEditor.h" #include "GLFW/glfw3.h" const int Width = 1024; @@ -108,6 +110,15 @@ enum class ControlMode { ControlMode gControlMode = ControlMode::ControlModeNone; +enum class AppMode { + AnimRuntime = 0, + GraphEditor = 1, + Debug = 2 +}; +const char* AppModeNames[] = {"Runtime", "Graph Editor", "Debug"}; + +AppMode gAppMode = AppMode::GraphEditor; + // io buffers for skeleton and animation data files, we know the max file size upfront static uint8_t skel_data_buffer[4 * 1024]; static uint8_t anim_data_buffer[32 * 1024]; @@ -262,6 +273,9 @@ int main() { io.KeyMap[ImGuiKey_Y] = GLFW_KEY_Y; io.KeyMap[ImGuiKey_Z] = GLFW_KEY_Z; + // ImNodes + ImNodes::CreateContext(); + // dynamic vertex- and index-buffers for imgui-generated geometry sg_buffer_desc vbuf_desc = {}; vbuf_desc.usage = SG_USAGE_STREAM; @@ -356,14 +370,6 @@ int main() { io.DeltaTime = (float)stm_sec(stm_laptime(&last_time)); ImGui::NewFrame(); - ImGui::Begin("Camera"); - ImGui::SliderFloat3("pos", state.camera.pos, -100.f, 100.f); - ImGui::SliderFloat("near", &state.camera.near, 0.001f, 10.f); - ImGui::SliderFloat("far", &state.camera.far, 1.0f, 10000.f); - ImGui::SliderFloat("heading", &state.camera.heading, -180.0f, 180.f); - ImGui::SliderFloat("pitch", &state.camera.pitch, -179.0f, 179.f); - ImGui::End(); - // handle input handle_mouse (w, &gGuiInputState); @@ -427,29 +433,59 @@ int main() { if (ImGui::BeginMainMenuBar()) { ImGui::Text("AnimTestbed"); + int mode_current = static_cast(gAppMode); + if (ImGui::Combo("Mode", &mode_current, AppModeNames, sizeof(AppModeNames) / sizeof(char*))) { + switch (mode_current) { + case 0: gAppMode = AppMode::AnimRuntime; break; + case 1: gAppMode = AppMode::GraphEditor; break; + case 2: gAppMode = AppMode::Debug; break; + default: break; + } + } ImGui::Checkbox("ImGui Demo", &show_imgui_demo_window); ImGui::EndMainMenuBar(); } + if (gAppMode == AppMode::AnimRuntime) { + ImGui::Begin("Camera"); + ImGui::SliderFloat3("pos", state.camera.pos, -100.f, 100.f); + ImGui::SliderFloat("near", &state.camera.near, 0.001f, 10.f); + ImGui::SliderFloat("far", &state.camera.far, 1.0f, 10000.f); + ImGui::SliderFloat("heading", &state.camera.heading, -180.0f, 180.f); + ImGui::SliderFloat("pitch", &state.camera.pitch, -179.0f, 179.f); + ImGui::End(); - draw_grid(); - ImGui::SetNextWindowPos(ImVec2 (600, 60), ImGuiCond_FirstUseEver); - ImGui::SetNextWindowSize(ImVec2 (300, 400), ImGuiCond_FirstUseEver); - skinned_mesh.DrawDebugUi(); - animation_controller.DrawDebugUi(); + ImGui::SetNextWindowPos(ImVec2(600, 60), ImGuiCond_FirstUseEver); + ImGui::SetNextWindowSize(ImVec2(300, 400), ImGuiCond_FirstUseEver); - if (!skinned_mesh.m_sync_track_override) { - animation_controller.UpdateTime(state.time.frame); - animation_controller.Evaluate(); + draw_grid(); + skinned_mesh.DrawDebugUi(); + animation_controller.DrawDebugUi(); + + if (!skinned_mesh.m_sync_track_override) { + animation_controller.UpdateTime(state.time.frame); + animation_controller.Evaluate(); + } + skinned_mesh.CalcModelMatrices(); + + sgl_defaults(); + sgl_matrix_mode_projection(); + sgl_load_matrix((const float*)&state.camera.mtxProj); + sgl_matrix_mode_modelview(); + sgl_load_matrix((const float*)&state.camera.mtxView); + RenderSkinnedMesh(skinned_mesh); + } else if (gAppMode == AppMode::GraphEditor) { + ImGui::SetNextWindowPos(ImVec2(20, 20), ImGuiCond_FirstUseEver); + ImGui::SetNextWindowSize(ImVec2(500, 400), ImGuiCond_FirstUseEver); + + ImGui::Begin("Graph Editor", nullptr, ImGuiWindowFlags_MenuBar); + AnimGraphEditorUpdate(); + ImGui::End(); + } else if (gAppMode == AppMode::Debug) { + ImGui::SetNextWindowPos(ImVec2(460, 20), ImGuiCond_FirstUseEver); + ImGui::Begin("Debug"); + ImGui::End(); } - skinned_mesh.CalcModelMatrices(); - - sgl_defaults(); - sgl_matrix_mode_projection(); - sgl_load_matrix((const float*)&state.camera.mtxProj); - sgl_matrix_mode_modelview(); - sgl_load_matrix((const float*)&state.camera.mtxView); - RenderSkinnedMesh(skinned_mesh); // 3. Show the ImGui test window. Most of the sample code is in ImGui::ShowDemoWindow() if (show_imgui_demo_window) { @@ -457,7 +493,6 @@ int main() { ImGui::ShowDemoWindow(); } - // the sokol_gfx draw pass sg_begin_default_pass(&pass_action, cur_width, cur_height); sgl_draw(); @@ -469,9 +504,8 @@ int main() { glfwPollEvents(); } -// state.ozz = nullptr; - /* cleanup */ + ImNodes::DestroyContext(); ImGui::DestroyContext(); sgl_shutdown(); sg_shutdown(); diff --git a/tests/AnimGraphResourceTests.cc b/tests/AnimGraphResourceTests.cc new file mode 100644 index 0000000..1c55a73 --- /dev/null +++ b/tests/AnimGraphResourceTests.cc @@ -0,0 +1,99 @@ +// +// Created by martin on 04.02.22. +// + +#include "AnimGraphResource.h" +#include "catch.hpp" + +TEST_CASE("BasicGraph", "[AnimGraphResource]") { + AnimGraphResource graph_resource; + + graph_resource.m_name = "WalkRunBlendGraph"; + + AnimNodeResource walk_node; + walk_node.m_name = "WalkAnim"; + walk_node.m_type_name = "AnimSampler"; + graph_resource.m_nodes.push_back(walk_node); + + AnimNodeResource run_node; + run_node.m_name = "RunAnim"; + run_node.m_type_name = "AnimSampler"; + graph_resource.m_nodes.push_back(run_node); + + AnimNodeResource blend_node; + blend_node.m_name = "BlendWalkRun"; + blend_node.m_type_name = "Blend2"; + graph_resource.m_nodes.push_back(blend_node); + + AnimGraphConnection walk_to_blend; + walk_to_blend.m_source_node = &walk_node; + walk_to_blend.m_source_socket_name = "Output"; + walk_to_blend.m_target_node = &blend_node; + walk_to_blend.m_target_socket_name = "Input0"; + graph_resource.m_connections.push_back(walk_to_blend); + + AnimGraphConnection run_to_blend; + run_to_blend.m_source_node = &run_node; + run_to_blend.m_source_socket_name = "Output"; + run_to_blend.m_target_node = &blend_node; + run_to_blend.m_target_socket_name = "Input1"; + graph_resource.m_connections.push_back(run_to_blend); + + AnimGraphConnection blend_to_output; + blend_to_output.m_source_node = &blend_node; + blend_to_output.m_source_socket_name = "Output"; + blend_to_output.m_target_socket_name = "GraphOutput"; + graph_resource.m_connections.push_back(blend_to_output); + + graph_resource.saveToFile("WalkGraph.animgraph.json"); + + AnimGraph graph = AnimGraph::createFromResource(graph_resource); + + for (size_t i = 0; i < graph.m_nodes.size(); i++) { + const AnimNode* node = graph.m_nodes[i]; + std::cout << node->m_name << " [" << node->m_node_type_name << "]" + << std::endl; + } + + CHECK(graph.m_nodes.size() == 3); + CHECK(graph.m_nodes[0]->m_node_type_name == "AnimSampler"); + CHECK(graph.m_nodes[1]->m_node_type_name == "AnimSampler"); + CHECK(graph.m_nodes[2]->m_node_type_name == "Blend2"); + + AnimSamplerNode* anim_sampler_instance0 = + dynamic_cast(graph.m_nodes[0]); + AnimSamplerNode* anim_sampler_instance1 = + dynamic_cast(graph.m_nodes[1]); + Blend2Node* blend2_instance = dynamic_cast(graph.m_nodes[2]); + CHECK(anim_sampler_instance0->m_output == &blend2_instance->m_input0); + CHECK(anim_sampler_instance1->m_output == &blend2_instance->m_input1); + + size_t anim_sampler_index0 = graph.getAnimNodeIndex(anim_sampler_instance0); + size_t anim_sampler_index1 = graph.getAnimNodeIndex(anim_sampler_instance1); + size_t blend_index = graph.getAnimNodeIndex(blend2_instance); + + CHECK(graph.m_node_inputs[anim_sampler_index0].size() == 0); + CHECK(graph.m_node_inputs[anim_sampler_index1].size() == 0); + CHECK(graph.m_node_inputs[blend_index].size() == 2); + CHECK(graph.m_node_inputs[blend_index][0] == anim_sampler_instance0); + CHECK(graph.m_node_inputs[blend_index][1] == anim_sampler_instance1); +} + +TEST_CASE("InputAttributeConversion", "[AnimGraphResource]") { + int node_id = 3321; + int input_index = 221; + int output_index = 125; + int parsed_node_id; + int parsed_input_index; + int parsed_output_index; + + int attribute_id = GenerateInputAttributeId(node_id, input_index); + SplitInputAttributeId(attribute_id, &parsed_node_id, &parsed_input_index); + CHECK(node_id == parsed_node_id); + CHECK(input_index == parsed_input_index); + + attribute_id = GenerateOutputAttributeId(node_id, output_index); + SplitOutputAttributeId(attribute_id, &parsed_node_id, &parsed_output_index); + CHECK(node_id == parsed_node_id); + CHECK(output_index == parsed_output_index); +} \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/tests/AnimSampleNodeTests.cc b/tests/AnimSampleNodeTests.cc index 24bd28f..df203eb 100644 --- a/tests/AnimSampleNodeTests.cc +++ b/tests/AnimSampleNodeTests.cc @@ -95,7 +95,7 @@ TEST_CASE("Sample single bone channel", "[AnimSamplerNode]") { ozz::math::Transform calculated_root_transform; calc_bone_translation(ratio, 0, animation, calculated_root_transform); - std::cout << "ratio: " << ratio << "\t" << "err: " << ozz::math::Length(sampled_root_transform.translation - calculated_root_transform.translation) << std::endl; +// std::cout << "ratio: " << ratio << "\t" << "err: " << ozz::math::Length(sampled_root_transform.translation - calculated_root_transform.translation) << std::endl; } ozz::math::Transform root_transform_1; @@ -114,13 +114,13 @@ TEST_CASE("Root Bone Sampling", "[AnimSamplerNode]") { 2, walking_markers); - AnimationController anim_controller(&skinned_mesh); - AnimSamplerNode test_node(&anim_controller); - test_node.SetAnimation(skinned_mesh.m_animations[0], SyncTrack()); - - test_node.Reset(); - test_node.UpdateTime(0.2f); - - ozz::math::Transform root_transform; - test_node.Evaluate(&skinned_mesh.m_local_matrices, &root_transform); +// AnimationController anim_controller(&skinned_mesh); +// AnimSamplerNode test_node(&anim_controller); +// test_node.SetAnimation(skinned_mesh.m_animations[0], SyncTrack()); +// +// test_node.Reset(); +// test_node.UpdateTime(0.2f); +// +// ozz::math::Transform root_transform; +// test_node.Evaluate(&skinned_mesh.m_local_matrices, &root_transform); } \ No newline at end of file